AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
AC–1
AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
1.
NOTICE FOR INITIALIZATION
When disconnecting the cable from the negative (-)
battery terminal, initialize the following system(s) after
the cable is reconnected.
System name
See procedure
Power Window Control System
See page WS-1
2.
3.
4.
5.
NOTICES FOR HYBRID SYSTEM ACTIVATION
• When the warning light is illuminated or the battery
has been disconnected and reconnected, pressing
the power switch may not start the system on the first
try. If so, press the power switch again.
• With the power switch's power mode changed to ON
(IG), disconnect the battery. If the key is not in the key
slot during reconnection, DTC B2799 may be output.
BECAUSE COMPRESSOR HAS HIGH-VOLTAGE
CIRCUIT, WEAR INSULATED GLOVES AND PULL
OUT SERVICE PLUG TO CUT HIGH-VOLTAGE
CIRCUIT BEFORE INSPECTION
DO NOT HANDLE REFRIGERANT IN AN ENCLOSED
AREA OR NEAR AN OPEN FLAME
ALWAYS WEAR EYE PROTECTION
AC02810E06
6.
AC02811E01
7.
8.
BE CAREFUL NOT TO GET LIQUID REFRIGERANT
IN YOUR EYES OR ON YOUR SKIN
If liquid refrigerant gets in your eyes or on your skin:
(a) Wash the area with lots of cold water.
CAUTION:
Do not rub your eyes or skin.
(b) Apply clean petroleum jelly to the skin.
(c) Go immediately to a hospital or see a physician for
professional treatment.
NEVER HEAT CONTAINER OR EXPOSE IT TO
NAKED FLAME
BE CAREFUL NOT TO DROP CONTAINER OR APPLY
PHYSICAL SHOCKS TO IT
AC
AC–2
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Wrong
LO
HI
9.
Okay
LO
HI
N011084E02
AC
DO NOT OPERATE COMPRESSOR WITHOUT
ENOUGH REFRIGERANT IN REFRIGERANT SYSTEM
If there is not enough refrigerant in the refrigerant
system, oil lubrication will be insufficient and compressor
burnout may occur. Necessary care should be taken to
avoid this.
10. DO NOT OPEN HIGH PRESSURE MANIFOLD VALVE
WHILE COMPRESSOR IS OPERATING
Open and close only the low pressure valve. If the high
pressure valves are opened, refrigerant flows in the
reverse direction causing the charging cylinder to
rupture.
11. BE CAREFUL NOT TO OVERCHARGE SYSTEM WITH
REFRIGERANT
If refrigerant is overcharged, it causes problems such as
insufficient cooling, poor fuel economy, engine
overheating, etc.
12. PRECAUTIONS TO BE OBSERVED WHILE
SERVICING
NOTICE:
• For the electric inverter compressor, use the NDOIL 11.
• Electrical insulation performance may decrease
significantly if even a small amount of oil other
than ND-OIL 11 is used or enters the refrigeration
cycle, causing a DTC to be output.
• Replace the main components (evaporator,
condenser, and compressor) if a large amount of
oil other than ND-OIL 11 enters the system. Failing
to do so may cause electrical insulation
performance to remain low, causing a DTC to be
output.
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves and pull out the service plug
clip before inspection, as some of the procedures
require disconnecting the high-voltage connectors.
AC–3
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
ENGINE ROOM NO. 2 RELAY BLOCK
- PS HTR RELAY*
INTEGRATION
- PTC HTR1 RELAY*
RELAY (UNIT C)
- PTC HTR2 RELAY*
PRESSURE SWITCH
FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK ASSEMBLY
(UNIT A)
- HTR H-FUSE
HEATER WATER PUMP ASSEMBLY
AMBIENT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
ENGINE ROOM JUNCTION BLOCK
- INTEGRATION RELAY
- FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK ASSEMBLY (HTR H-FUSE)
- PS HTR H-FUSE*
- PTC HTR1 FUSE*
- PTC HTR2 FUSE*
ELECTRIC INVERTER COMPRESSOR
(w/ MOTOR COMPRESSOR ASSEMBLY)
AIR CONDITIONING INVERTER
(INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY)
*: Cold Area Models
E118676E01
AC
AC–4
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
STEERING PAD SWITCH LH
SPIRAL CABLE
STEERING PAD SWITCH RH
COMBINATION METER
MULTI-DISPLAY
GATEWAY ECU
SOLAR SENSOR
HYBRID
CONTROL ECU
ECM
DLC3
DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
- MAIN BODY ECU
- HTR RELAY
- A/C (HTR) FUSE
- GAUGE FUSE
- ECU-B FUSE
AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
(AIR CONDITIONING CONTROL ASSEMBLY)
ROOM TEMPERATURE SENSOR
(Built in ROOM HUMIDITY SENSOR)
E118677E01
AC
AC–5
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
NO. 1 COOLER EVAPORATOR
COOLER
EXPANSION
VALVE
AIR INLET CONTROL
SERVO MOTOR
BLOWER
ASSEMBLY
EVAPORATOR
TEMPERATURE
SENSOR
AIR OUTLET CONTROL
SERVO MOTOR
PTC HEATER*
AIR MIX CONTROL
SERVO MOTOR
BLOWER WITH FAN MOTOR
SUB-ASSEMBLY
AIR CONDITIONING RADIATOR
ASSEMBLY
HEATER RADIATOR
UNIT ASSEMBLY
*: Cold Area Models
E118678E02
AC
AC–6
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
Air Conditioning
Amplifier
Gateway ECU
Combination Meter
ECU
Main Body ECU
Multi-display
Hybrid Control ECU
ECM
: BEAN
: AVC-LAN
: CAN
E125227E02
AC
AC–7
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Transmitter
Receiver
Line
Signal
Air Conditioning Amplifier
Combination Meter ECU
BEAN
Ambient temperature
A/C AUTO indicator display signal
Room temperature indicator
display signal
Fr. DEF indicator display signal
Rr. DEF indicator display signal
Multi-display
AVC-LAN
Ambient temperature
AUTO, FRS, REC, Fr.DEF,
Rr.DEF, A/C, FACE, B/L, FOOT,
F/D display signal
Buzzer sounding signal
A/C indicator screen display
signal
A/C diagnosis status signal
Blower airflow volume display
signal
A/C function information signal
(rear A/C, A/C type (single, right/
left independent), Rec/Frs
control, temperature display, air
purifier presence, blower step,
destination)
Inside multi-display D/P seats
temperature display signal
Hybrid Control ECU
CAN
Compressor operation signal
A/C status signal
Water pump ON / OFF demand
signal
E/G ON demand signal
ECM
CAN
Water temperature signal
E/G speed signal
Ambient temperature signal
Thermal storage 3-port valve
heater side closed signal
AC
AC–8
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Transmitter
Receiver
Line
Signal
Combination Meter ECU
Air Conditioning Amplifier
BEAN
Vehicle speed signal
BEAN
DTC clear signal
Body ECU
Diagnosis tool demand signal
Vehicle specs signal
Multi-display
AVC-LAN
Hybrid Control ECU
CAN
A/C operation signal
A/C control signal
Use permissible power signal
A/C water pump operation signal
Standby condition signal
Shift position signal
Drive ready indication signal
SOC level data signal
EV mode state signal
A/C motor speed signal
A/C input power signal
A/C motor current flow order
signal
A/C inverter temperature signal
A/C inverter voltage signal
A/C ECU diagnosis signal
AC
AC–9
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Air Mix Servo Motor
Fan Relays
Air Mix Damper
Position Sensor
Air Outlet
Servo Motor
Air Outlet Damper
Position Sensor
Heater Relay
Blower Motor
Controller
Blower Motor
Rear Defogger
Relay
Rear Defogger
Mirror Heater
Relay
Mirror Heater
Air Conditioning
Amplifier
Air Inlet
Servo Motor
PTC Relay*
PTC Heater*
(in Heater Core)
PTC Relay*
PTC Heater*
(in Air Duct)
Air Inlet Damper
Position Sensor
Room Temperature
Sensor
Room Humidity
Sensor
*: Cold Area Models
E125228E02
AC
AC–10
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Evaporator Temperature
Sensor
Combination
Meter ECU
A/C Indicator Light
Gateway ECU
Multi-display
Solar Sensor
Wiper Switch
Converter
Air Conditioning
Amplifier
ECM
- Engine Coolant Temperature
- Ambient Temperature
- Engine Speed
Battery ECU
- Room Temperature and Ambient
Temperature Sensor Signal Reception
- Blower Motor Mode Reception
- Hybrid Battery Cooling System Reception
Steering Pad Switch
Pressure Switch
: BEAN
Hybrid Control ECU
- Compressor Control Signal Reception
- Blower Motor Mode Reception
- Water Pump Control Signal Reception
A/C Inverter
Water Pump Relay
Electric Inverter
Compressor
A/C Water Pump
: AVC-LAN
: CAN
E125229E03
AC
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
AC–11
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
2.
3.
GENERAL
The air conditioning system has the following features:
• An ES18 type Electric Inverter Compressor is used.
This compressor is driven by an alternating current
provided by the A/C inverter, which is built into the
inverter of the hybrid system.
As a result, the air conditioning system is actuated
without depending on the operation of the engine,
thus realizing a comfortable air conditioning system
and low fuel consumption.
• A blower motor controller, which regulates the speed
of the blower motor by controlling the output voltage
in accordance with the duty cycle signal provided by
the air conditioning amplifier, is used.
As a result, the power loss associated with the heat
generation of the conventional blower linear controller
is reduced, thus realizing low fuel consumption.
• A humidity sensor function is added to the room
temperature sensor in order to optimize the amount of
dehumidification effort during the operation of the air
conditioning system.
• A compact, lightweight and highly efficient RS
(Revolutionary Slim) evaporator is used.
• A compact, lightweight and highly efficient MF-IV
(Multi Flow-IV) condenser is used.
• A compact, lightweight, and highly efficient electrical
water pump is used in order to ensure the proper
heater performance while the engine is stopped.
• Fuzzy control is used for calculating the required
outlet air temperature (TAO: Temperature Air Outlet)
and the blower volume in the automatic air
conditioning control system. Accordingly, the air
conditioning ECU is able to calculate the outlet air
temperature, blower volume, air outlet, and
compressor speed that is suited to the operating
environment. As a result, the comfort level of the
occupants is improved.
AIR CONDITIONING OPERATION
• The air conditioning is controlled by using the
switches that appear on the air conditioning screen
display of the multi-display and the switches provided
on the steering pad.
• In addition to the air conditioning screen display, the
operating conditions of the AUTO, RECIRCULATION,
front DEF, and rear DEF switches are indicated by the
indicator lights in the combination meter.
HEATER CORE AND PTC HEATER
• A compact, lightweight, and highly efficient straight
flow (full-path flow) aluminum heater core is used. A
PTC (Positive Temperature Coefficient) heater is built
into the heater core tube.
AC
AC–12
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
4.
AC
• The PTC heater contains electrodes that are
interposed with a PTC element, to which current is
applied in order to warm the air that passes through
the fins.
• The PTC heater is provided in the air duct at the
footwell outlet in front of the air conditioning unit. This
PTC heater, which is a honeycomb-shaped PTC
thermistor, directly warms the air that flows in the
duct.
COMPRESSOR
• ES18 Electric Inverter Compressor is actuated by a
built-in electric motor.
• The electric motor is actuated by the alternating
current power (201.6 V) supplied by the A/C inverter,
which is integrated in the hybrid system inverter. As a
result, the air conditioning control system is actuated
without depending on the operation of the engine,
thus realizing a comfortable air conditioning system
and low fuel consumption.
• The electric inverter compressor controls the
compressor speed at the required speed calculated
by the air conditioning amplifier. Thus, cooling,
dehumidification performance and power
consumption are optimized.
• The suction and discharge hoses at the compressor
are low-moisture permeation hoses. This minimizes
the entry of moisture into the refrigeration cycle.
• The compressor uses high-voltage alternating
current. If a short or open circuit occurs in the
compressor wiring harness, the hybrid control ECU
will cut off the A/C inverter circuit in order to stop the
power supply to the compressor.
• The Electric Inverter Compressor consists of a spirally
wound fixed scroll and variable scroll that form a pair,
a brushless motor, an oil separator, and a motor shaft.
• The fixed scroll is integrated with the housing.
Because the rotation of the shaft causes the variable
scroll to revolve while maintaining the same posture,
the volume of the space that is partitioned by both
scrolls varies to perform the suction, compression,
and the discharge of the refrigerant gas.
• Locating the suction port directly above the scrolls
enables direct suction, thus realizing improved
suction efficiency.
• Containing a built-in oil separator, this compressor is
able to separate the compressor oil that is intermixed
with the refrigerant and circulates in the refrigeration
cycle, thus realizing a reduction in the oil circulation
rate.
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
AC–13
HINT:
In order ensure the proper insulation of the internal highvoltage portion of the compressor and the compressor
housing, a compressor oil (ND-OIL 11) with a high level
of insulation performance is used. Therefore, never use
a compressor oil other than the ND-OIL 11 type
compressor oil or its equivalent.
Variable Scroll
Fixed Scroll
Oil Separator
Motor Shaft
Discharge Port
Brushless Motor
I036336E01
5.
to Heater
from Engine
6.
I036337E01
WATER PUMP
• An electrical water pump is used. This provides a
stable heater performance even if the engine is
stopped because of a function of the THS-ll.
• A new type of electrical water pump is used in which
the water flow resistance has been reduced.
ROOM TEMPERATURE SENSOR AND HUMIDITY
SENSOR
• A humidity sensor function is used by the room
temperature sensor. By enabling the detection of
humidity in the vehicle interior, this function optimizes
the amount of dehumidification effort during the
operation of the air conditioning system. As a result,
the power consumption of the compressor has been
reduced and a comfortable level of humidity has been
realized in the vehicle interior.
• The humidity-sensing resistance film that is built into
the humidity sensor absorbs and releases the
humidity in the vehicle interior. During the absorption
and releasing processes, the humidity-sensing
resistance film expands (during the absorption of
humidity) and contracts (during drying). The
clearance between the carbon particles in the
humidity-sensing resistance film expands and
contracts during absorption and drying, thus changing
the resistance between the electrodes. The air
conditioning amplifier determines the humidity in the
vehicle interior through the changes in the output
voltage of the humidity sensor that are caused by the
resistance between the electrodes.
AC
AC–14
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
7.
Air
Conditioning
Amplifier
Duty Signal
BLOWER MOTOR CONTROLLER
The blower motor controller controls the voltage that is
output to the blower motor in accordance with the duty
cycle signals that are input by the air conditioning
amplifier. It is characterized by a smaller amount of heat
generation than the blower controller used on the
previous model. As a result, the power loss associated
with the heat generation of the conventional blower
linear controller has been reduced, thus realizing low fuel
consumption.
M+
13
Blower
Motor
Controller
Output
Voltage
(V)
M-
4
30
90
Duty Ratio (%)
I036338E02
8.
Control
Outline
Fuzzy Control
The fuzzy control determines the conformity
levels of the temperature deviation, ambient
temperature, and solar radiation by defining
their respective mathematical functions. In
addition, a fuzzy calculation method is used to
calculate the required outlet air temperature
(TAO) and the blower volume. Based on
these calculations, the air conditioning
amplifier effects the respective controls for the
outlet air temperature, blower volume,
compressor, and air outlet.
Outlet Air Temp. Control
AC
AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
The air conditioning ECU has the following controls.
Air Mix Damper Control
In response to the temperature control switch
setting, the required outlet air temperature,
evaporator temperature sensor, and engine
coolant temperature sensor compensations
are used by the air mix control damper control
to calculate a tentative damper opening
angle, through an arithmetic circuit in the air
mix damper, to arrive at a target damper
opening angle.
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Control
Blower Control
Air Outlet Control
AC–15
Outline
Blower Motor Start Up Control
When the blower motor is started up, the air
conditioning amplifier transmits a blower
motor actuation signal with a low duty cycle
ratio to the blower pulse controller, which
applies a low voltage to the blower motor, in
order to operate the blower motor for 3
seconds at a low speed. This is designed to
protect the blower pulse controller from a
sudden start-up voltage surge.
Manual Control
Sets the blower speed according to operation
of the blower switch.
Automatic Control
Step Less Air Volume Control:
• When the AUTO switch located on the
steering pad switch is pushed, or the air
conditioning screen display of the multidisplay is touched, the air conditioning
amplifier automatically regulates the duty
ratio to the blower pulse controller in
accordance with a calculation result by
the fuzzy control in order to deliver step
less air volume.
Warm-up Control:
• When the air outlet is in the FOOT, BILEVEL, or FOOT/DEF mode, the blower
will not operate until the engine coolant
temperature increases above a
prescribed value. When the temperature
increases above a prescribed value, the
blower motor operates at the LO speed.
Time-Lagged Air Flow Control:
• 2 types of time-lagged air flow control (in
accordance with the detected by the
evaporator temperature sensor) help
prevent hot air from being emitted from
FACE or BI-LEVEL vent.
Sunlight Air Flow Control:
• Controls the blower speed in accordance
with the intensity of the sunlight when the
air outlet mode is at FACE or BI-LEVEL.
The blower speed can be adjusted in
response to the signal received from the
solar sensor.
Manual Control
Changes the air outlet in accordance with the
selected position of the mode select switch.
Automatic Control
Mode Damper Switching Servo motor
Control:
• When the AUTO switch is pushed,
automatic control causes the mode servo
motor to rotate to a desired position in
accordance with the target damper
opening, which is based on the
calculation of the TAO.
Low-Temperature FOOT/DEF Control:
• In accordance with the engine coolant
temperature, ambient temperature,
amount of sunlight, required outlet
temperature (TAO), and vehicle speed
conditions, this control automatically
switches the blower outlet between the
FOOT / DEF modes to prevent the
window from becoming fogged when the
outside air temperature is low.
AC
AC–16
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Control
Air Inlet Control
Outline
Manual Control
Drives the air inlet servo motor according to
the operation of the air inlet control switch and
fixes the dampers in the FRESH or RECIRC
position.
Automatic Control
Automatic RECIRC / FRESH Control:
• When the AUTO switch is pressed, the
system controls the servo motor so that
the air inlet is as calculated in accordance
with the TAO.
DEF Mode Control:
• When switching the mode switching
switch to DEF mode, air conditioning
amplifier turns MAX mode ON forcibly
and switched to FRESH mode.
• When switching the mode switching
switch to FOOT / DEF mode, air
conditioning amplifier switches to FRESH
mode.
2-Way Flow Mode Control
At the time of selecting FRESH mode, the air
conditioning amplifier will judge it as 2-way
flow mode when the blower outlet is set to
FOOT or FOOT / DEF, the tentative air mix
damper opening angle is above the specified
value (MAX HOT), and either the blower
volume is more than the specified volume or
the vehicle speed is less than the specified
speed.
Half Inlet Air Mode Control
At the time of selecting FRESH mode, the air
conditioning amplifier will judge it as half inlet
air mode when the blower outlet mode is set
to FACE or BI-LEVEL and TAO is more than
the specified temperature, and operates both
outlet air introduction and inlet air circulation
at the same time.
Electric Inverter Compressor Control
Compressor Speed Control
•
•
Electrical Water Pump Control
AC
The air conditioning amplifier calculates
target speed of the compressor based on
the target evaporator temperature (which
is calculated by the room temperature
sensor, humidity sensor, ambient
temperature sensor, and the solar sensor)
and the actual evaporator temperature
that is detected by the evaporator
temperature sensor in order to control the
compressor speed.
The air conditioning amplifier calculates
the target evaporator temperature, which
includes corrections based on the vehicle
interior humidity (which is obtained from
the humidity sensor) and the windshield
glass inner surface humidity (which is
calculated from the humidity sensor, solar
sensor, room temperature sensor, mode
damper position, and wiper operation
condition). Accordingly, the air
conditioning amplifier controls the
compressor speed to an extent that would
not inhibit the proper cooling performance
or defogging performance.
The electrical water pump is used in order to
ensure the proper heater performance while
the blower motor is ON and the engine is
stopped.
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
AC–17
Control
Outline
Engine Start Request Control
To ensure the proper heater performance
when the hybrid system is started at low
temperatures, the air conditioning amplifier
transmits an engine start request to the hybrid
control ECU in accordance with the TAO,
engine coolant temperature sensor signal,
and ambient temperature sensor signal.
PTC Heater Control
When the hybrid system is operating
(READY) and the blower motor is turned ON,
the air conditioning amplifier turns on the PTC
heater if the conditions listed below are met.
Heater core integrated PTC heater
• Air outlet is in the FOOT, FOOT / DEF or
DEF mode.
• Engine coolant temperature is below
specified temperature.
• Ambient temperature is below specified
temperature (DEF mode).
• Tentative air mix damper opening angle is
above the specified value (MAX HOT).
Footwell air duct integrated PTC heater
• Air outlet is in the FOOT or FOOT / DEF
mode.
• Engine coolant temperature is below
specified temperature.
• Tentative air mix damper opening angle is
above the specified value (MAX HOT).
Electric Cooling Fan Control
The air conditioning amplifier control the
cooling fan in accordance with the vehicle
speed signal and compressor speed signal.
Rear Window Defogger Control
Switches the rear defogger and outside rear
view mirror heaters on for 15 minutes when
the rear defogger switch is switched on.
Switches them off if the switch is pressed
while they are operating.
Outer Temperature Indication Control
Based on the signals from the ambient
temperature sensor, this control calculates
the outside temperature, which is then
corrected in the air conditioning ECU, and
shown in the multi-display.
Self-Diagnosis
Checks the sensor and A/C inverter in
accordance with operation of the air
conditioning switches, then the heater control
panel displays a DTC (Diagnosis Trouble
Code) to indicate if there is a malfunction or
not (sensor check function).
Drives the actuators through a predetermined
sequence in accordance with the operation of
the air conditioning switches (actuator check
function).
AC
AC–18
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
9.
AC
ELECTRIC INVERTER COMPRESSOR CONTROL
• The air conditioning amplifier calculates the target
compressor speed based on the target evaporator
temperature (calculated from the room temperature
sensor, humidity sensor, ambient temperature sensor,
and solar sensor) and the actual evaporator
temperature detected by the evaporator temperature
sensor. Then, the air conditioning amplifier transmits
the target speed to the hybrid control ECU. The hybrid
control ECU controls the A/C inverter based on the
target speed data in order to control the compressor
to a speed that suits the operating condition of the air
conditioning system.
AC–19
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
• The air conditioning amplifier calculates the target
evaporator temperature, which includes corrections
based on the vehicle interior humidity (which is
obtained from the humidity sensor) and the
windshield glass inner surface humidity (which is
calculated from the humidity sensor, solar sensor,
room temperature sensor, mode damper position, and
wiper operation condition). Accordingly, the air
conditioning amplifier controls the compressor speed
to an extent that does not inhibit the proper cooling
performance or defogging performance. As a result,
comfort and low fuel consumption can be realized.
Electric Inverter
Compressor
Room Temp.
Sensor
Air Conditioning
Amplifier
Room Humidity
Sensor
Automatic Light
Control Sensor
A/C Inverter
Calculates target
compressor speed
in accordance with
various input
conditions.
Inverter Control
Target Compressor
Speed
Evaporator Temp.
Sensor
Hybrid Control
ECU
Ambient Temp.
Air Outlet Damper
Position Sensor
Wiper Switch
Wiper Motor
Ambient Temp.
Sensor
E109275E03
AC
AC–20
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
10. MODEL POSITION AND DAMPER OPERATION
Side Defroster
Fresh Air
2
Center Defroster
12 11
13
Recirc. Air 14
5
1
20 21
19
6
Clean Air Filter
3 4
7
Side Defroster
8
9
10
Front Footwell
Register Duct
18
151617
23
22
Rear Footwell
Register Duct
Blower Motor
Evaporator
Heater Core
Side Register
Center Register
Side Register
E125225E01
A
E
B
F
G
H
C
K
I
J
D
L
E125226E01
Function of main damper
Control Damper
Control Position
Damper
Position
Indicator OFF
1, 3
Brings in fresh air.
2, 4
Brings in fresh air while circulating
internal air.
2, 4
Recirculates internal air.
C or I
AC
Air Inlet Control
Damper
Operation
Indicator ON
C or I
AC–21
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Control Damper
Air Mix Control
Damper
A, B or K, L
Control Position
Damper
Position
Operation
-
5, 8 to 6, 9 to 7,
10
Varies mixture ratio of fresh air and
recirculation air in order to regulate
temperature continuously from HOT to
COOL.
FACE
E
14, 15, 21, 22
(14, 16, 21,
22)*2
Air blows out of center registers and
side registers.
14, 17, 20, 22
Air mainly blows out of center registers,
side registers, and footwell register
ducts.
13, 18, 19, 22
(12, 17, 19,
23)*1
Air mainly blows out of front and rear
footwell register ducts.
In addition, air blows out slightly from
front and side defrosters, and side
registers.
12, 17, 19, 22
(11, 15, 19,
23)*1
Air mainly blows out of front and side
defrosters to defrost windshield. Air
also blows out from front and rear
footwell register ducts, and side
registers.
12, 17, 19, 22
Air blows out of front and side
defrosters and side registers to defrost
windshield.
BI-LEVEL
F
FOOT
Mode Control
Damper
G
FOOT/DEF
H
DEF
D or J
HINT:
*1: During 2-way flow control
*2: Early stage of COOL during AUTO
AC
AC–22
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
11. AIR OUTLETS AND AIR VOLUME RATIOS
D
D
B
A
A
D
B
C
C
C
C
E125224E01
Air Outlet Position Symbol
Air Outlet Mode
FACE
BI-LEVEL
FOOT
AC
FOOT/DEF
A
B
C
D
Center Face
Side Face
Foot
Defroster
AC–23
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Air Outlet Position Symbol
Air Outlet Mode
A
B
C
D
Center Face
Side Face
Foot
Defroster
DEF
HINT:
1. The circle size ({) indicates the proportion of the
airflow volume.
2. The (-) indicates that the air is not blown out.
3. The (*) indicates the early stage of COOL during
AUTO.
AC
AC–24
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
• Use these procedures to troubleshoot the air conditioning
system.
• *: Use the intelligent tester.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS
(a) Confirm the problem symptoms.
NEXT
3
CHECK AND CLEAR DTCS*
NEXT
4
PROBLEM SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION
Result
Result
Proceed to
Symptom does not occur
A
Symptom occurs
B
B
GO TO STEP 6
A
5
SYMPTOM SIMULATION
NEXT
6
CHECK MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM*
(a) Check for the DTC outputs.
Result
AC
Result
Proceed to
No multiplex DTC
A
Multiplex DTC output
B
B
GO TO MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION
SYSTEM
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
7
AC–25
CHECK CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM*
Result
Result
Proceed to
No CAN DTC
A
CAN DTC output
B
B
GO TO CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
A
8
DTC CHECK (OTHER THAN MULTIPLEX DTC)*
Result
Result
Proceed to
Malfunction code
A
Normal code
B
B
GO TO STEP 10
A
9
DTC CHART
NEXT
10
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NEXT
11
TERMINALS OF ECU
NEXT
12
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
NEXT
13
IDENTIFICATION OF PROBLEM
NEXT
AC
AC–26
14
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
REPAIR OR REPLACE
NEXT
15
NEXT
END
AC
CONFIRMATION TEST
AC–27
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
CUSTOMIZE PARAMETERS
HINT:
The following items can be customized.
NOTICE:
• When the customer requests a change in a function,
first make sure that the function can be customized.
• Be sure to make a note of the current settings before
customizing.
• When troubleshooting a function, first make sure that
the function is set to the default setting.
Air conditioning amplifier
Display (Item)
Default
Contents
Setting
SET TEMP SHIFT (Set
Temperature Shift)
NORMAL
To control with the shifted
temperature against the display
temperature.
+2C / +1C / NORMAL / -1C / -2C
AIR INLET MODE (Air Inlet
Mode)
AUTO
In case of turning the A/C ON
when you desire to make the
compartment cool down quickly,
this is the function to change the
mode automatically to
RECIRCULATED mode.
MANUAL / AUTO
COMPRESSOR MODE
(Compressor Mode)
AUTO
Function to turn the A/C ON
automatically by pressing the
AUTO button when the blower is
ON and the A/C is OFF.
MANUAL / AUTO
COMPRS/DEF OPER
(Compressor/Air inlet DEF
operation)
LINK
Function to turn the A/C ON
automatically linking with the
FRONT DEF button when the A/C
is OFF.
NORMAL / LINK
FOOT/DEF MODE (Foot/DEF
auto mode)
ON
Function to turn the air flow from
FOOT/DEF to ON automatically
when AUTO MODE is ON.
OFF / ON
AUTO BLOW UP (Foot/DEF
automatic blow up function)
ON
Function to switch the blower
level automatically when the
defroster is ON.
OFF / ON
FOOT AIR LEAK (Foot air leak)
ON
Function to cut off the airstream
felt underfoot while the vehicle is
moving.
OFF / ON
AMBINT TMP SFT (Ambient
Temperature Shift)
NORMAL
To control with the shifted
ambient temperature against the
display ambient temperature.
+3C / +2C / +1C / NORMAL / -1C
/ -2C / -3C
AC
AC–28
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
• Use the table below to help determine the cause of the
problem symptom. The potential causes of the symptoms
are listed in order of probability in the "Suspected area"
column of the table. Check each symptom by checking the
suspected areas in the order they are listed. Replace parts
as necessary.
• Inspect the fuses and relays related to this system before
inspecting the suspected areas below.
Air conditioning system
Symptom
Entire A/C system does not operate
Air Flow Control: No blower operation
Air Flow Control: No blower control
Air Flow Control: Insufficient air output
Temperature Control: No cool air comes out
Temperature Control: No warm air comes out
Temperature Control: Output air is warmer or cooler
than set temperature or response is slow
AC
Suspected area
1. IG power source circuit
See page
AC-132
2. Air conditioning amplifier
AC-28
1. Blower motor circuit
AC-110
2. Air conditioning amplifier
AC-28
1. Blower motor circuit
AC-110
2. Air conditioning amplifier
AC-28
1. Blower motor circuit
AC-110
2. Air conditioning amplifier
AC-28
1. Volume of refrigerant
AC-136
2. Refrigerant pressure
AC-136
3. Pressure switch circuit
AC-59
4. Air mix damper control servo motor circuit
AC-77
5. Air mix damper position sensor circuit
AC-63
6. Room temperature sensor circuit
AC-42
7. Room humidity sensor circuit
AC-89
8. Ambient temperature sensor circuit
AC-46
9. A/C inverter circuit
AC-93
10. Air conditioning amplifier
AC-28
11. Multiplex communication circuit
MP-1
1. Air mix damper control servo motor circuit
AC-77
2. Air mix damper position sensor circuit
AC-63
3. Ambient temperature sensor circuit
AC-42
4. Room temperature sensor circuit
AC-42
5. Room humidity sensor circuit
AC-89
6. Evaporator temperature sensor circuit
AC-51
7. Air conditioning amplifier
AC-28
8. Multiplex communication circuit
MP-1
9. Heater radiator
-
1. Steering pad switch circuit
AC-125
2. Room temperature sensor circuit
AC-42
3. Room humidity sensor circuit
AC-89
4. Ambient temperature sensor circuit
AC-46
5. Solar sensor circuit
AC-55
6. Air mix damper control servo motor circuit
AC-77
7. Air mix damper position sensor circuit
AC-63
8. Air conditioning amplifier
AC-28
9. Multiplex communication circuit
MP-1
AC–29
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Symptom
Temperature Control: No temperature control (only
Max. cool or Max. warm)
No air inlet control
No air outlet control
Engine idle up does not occur, or is continuous
Displayed set temperature value does not match with
operation of temperature control switch
Suspected area
See page
1. Steering wheel pad switch circuit
AC-125
2. Air mix damper control servo motor circuit
AC-77
3. Air mix damper position sensor circuit
AC-63
4. Air conditioning amplifier
AC-28
1. Air inlet damper control servo motor circuit
AC-81
2. Air inlet damper position sensor circuit
AC-67
3. Air conditioning amplifier
AC-28
1. Air outlet damper control servo motor circuit
AC-85
2. Air outlet damper position sensor circuit
AC-72
3. Air conditioning amplifier
AC-28
1. A/C inverter circuit
AC-93
2. Air conditioning amplifier
AC-28
3. Multiplex communication circuit
MP-1
1. Air conditioning amplifier
AC-28
Brightness does not change when rheostat volume or
light control switch is adjusted
1. Illumination light system
LI-1
2. Air conditioning amplifier
AC-28
Unable to access the diagnosis mode
1. Air conditioning amplifier
AC-28
DTC not recorded. Set mode is cleared when power
switch is turned OFF.
1. Back-up power source circuit
AC-134
2. Air conditioning amplifier
AC-28
1. Steering pad switch circuit
AC-125
2. Air conditioning amplifier
AC-28
1. Multiplex communication circuit
MP-1
2. Multi-display
-
3. Air conditioning amplifier
AC-28
Unable to control A/C with the steering pad switch
Unable to control A/C with the multi-display
The heater performance is low (PTC heater does not
function)*
1. PTC heater circuit
AC-121
2. Heater water pump circuit
AC-118
3. Air conditioning amplifier
AC-28
4. Multiplex communication circuit
MP-1
HINT:
*: The PTC heater operation may be stopped when an
electrical load is large on the entire vehicle.
AC
AC–30
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
TERMINALS OF ECU
A8
A7
I036314E07
1.
AC
CHECK AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
(a) Measure the voltage and resistance of the
connectors.
HINT:
Check from the rear of the connector while it is
connected to the air conditioning amplifier.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
AIR (A8-22) - GND (A8-1)
G - W-B
Recirculation / Fresh
switch signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Recirculation / Fresh
switch: FRESH
Below 1 V
AIR (A8-22) - GND (A8-1)
G - W-B
Recirculation / Fresh
switch signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Recirculation / Fresh
switch: RECIRC
10 to 14 V
AIF (A8-23) - GND (A8-1)
P - W-B
Recirculation / Fresh
switch signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Recirculation / Fresh
switch: RECIRC
Below 1 V
AIF (A8-23) - GND (A8-1)
P - W-B
Recirculation / Fresh
switch signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Recirculation / Fresh
switch: FRESH
10 to 14 V
AOF (A8-16) - GND (A8-1) B - W-B
Mode switch signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Mode switch: DEF
Below 1 V
AOF (A8-16) - GND (A8-1) B - W-B
Mode switch signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Mode switch: FACE
10 to 14 V
AOD (A8-24) - GND (A81)
Y - W-B
Mode switch signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Mode switch: FACE
Below 1 V
AOD (A8-24) - GND (A81)
Y - W-B
Mode switch signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Mode switch: DEF
10 to 14 V
TPI (A7-19) - SGTPI (A74)
V-L
Recirculation / Fresh
switch signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Recirculation / Fresh
switch: RECIRC
4V
TPI (A7-19) - SGTPI (A74)
V-L
Recirculation / Fresh
switch signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Recirculation / Fresh
switch: FRESH
1V
TPM (A7-18) - SGTPM
(A7-23)
LG - P
Mode switch signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Mode switch: FACE
4V
TPM (A7-18) - SGTPM
(A7-23)
LG - P
Mode switch signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Mode switch: DEF
1V
TP (A7-20) - SGTP (A714)
L - LG
Temperature switch signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Temperature switch: Max.
COOL
4V
TP (A7-20) - SGTP (A714)
L - LG
Temperature switch signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Temperature switch: Max.
HOT
1V
SGTE (A7-5) - Body
ground
Y - Body ground
Ground for evaporator
temperature sensor
Always
Below 1 Ω
AC–31
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
TE (A7-7) - SGTE (A7-5)
B-Y
Evaporator temperature
sensor signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Evaporator temperature:
15°C (59°F)
2 to 2.4 V
TE (A7-7) - SGTE (A7-5)
B-Y
Evaporator temperature
sensor signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Evaporator temperature:
15°C (59°F)
1.4 to 1.8 V
S5TPI (A7-3) - SGTPI (A74)
B-L
Power supply for air inlet
damper position sensor
Power switch ON (IG)
4.5 to 5.5 V
AMC (A8-19) - GND (A81)
B - W-B
Temperature switch
Power switch ON (IG)
Temperature switch: Max.
HOT
Below 1 V
AMC (A8-19) - GND (A81)
B - W-B
Temperature switch
Power switch ON (IG)
Temperature switch: Max.
COOL
10 to 14 V
AMH (A8-17) - GND (A81)
R - W-B
Temperature switch
Power switch ON (IG)
Temperature switch: Max.
COOL
Below 1 V
AMH (A8-17) - GND (A81)
R - W-B
Temperature switch
Power switch ON (IG)
Temperature switch: Max.
HOT
10 to 14 V
SGTPI (A7-4) - Body
ground
L - Body ground
Ground for air inlet
damper position sensor
Always
Below 1 Ω
SGTPM (A7-23) - Body
ground
P - Body ground
Ground for air outlet
damper position sensor
Always
Below 1 Ω
SGTP (A7-14) - Body
ground
LG - Body ground
Ground for air mix damper
position sensor
Always
Below 1 Ω
S5TPM (A7-11) - SGTPM
(A7-23)
O-P
Power supply for air outlet
damper position sensor
signal
Power switch ON (IG)
4.5 to 5.5 V
S5TP (A7-13) - SGTP (A714)
P - LG
Power supply for air mix
damper position sensor
signal
Power switch ON (IG)
4.5 to 5.5 V
IG (A8-5) - GND (A8-1)
B - W-B
Power switch signal
Power switch control OFF
0V
IG (A8-5) - GND (A8-1)
B - W-B
Power switch signal
Power switch control ON
(ACC)
10 to 14 V
+B (A8-6) - GND (A8-1)
Y - W-B
Back-up power source
Always
10 to 14 V
MPX+ (A8-3) - GND (A81)
B - W-B
Terminal for BEAN
Engine idling after engine
warmed up
Pulse generation
MPX2+ (A8-11) - GND
(A8-1)
GR - W-B
Terminal for BEAN
Engine idling after engine
warmed up
Pulse generation
GND (A8-1) - Body ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground for main power
supply
Always
Below 1 Ω
BLW (A8-2) - GND (A8-1)
W - W-B
Blower switch signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Blower switch ON (IG)
Pulse generation (see
waveform 1)
S5TS (A7-12) - TS (A7-21)
GR - W-B
Solar sensor signal
Power switch ON (IG)
0.8 to 4.3 V
HR (A8-7) - GND (A8-1)
B - W-B
Blower switch signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Blower switch: OFF
10 to 14 V
HR (A8-7) - GND (A8-1)
B - W-B
Blower switch signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Blower switch: ON
Below 1 V
TR (A7-8) - SGTR (A7-22)
B-W
Room temperature sensor
signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Cabin temperature: 25°C
(77°F)
1.8 to 2.2 V
TR (A7-8) - SGTR (A7-22)
B-W
Room temperature sensor
signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Cabin temperature: 40°C
(104°F)
1.2 to 1.6 V
SGTR (A7-22) - Body
ground
W - Body ground
Ground for room
temperature sensor
Always
Below 1 Ω
AC
AC–32
AC
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
ST1 (A7-2) - SGST (A715)
BR - G
Steering pad switch signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Steering pad switch: Fr.
DEF
Below 0.3 V
ST1 (A7-2) - SGST (A715)
BR - G
Steering pad switch signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Steering pad switch: Rr.
DEF
0.8 to 1.5 V
ST1 (A7-2) - SGST (A715)
BR - G
Steering pad switch signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Steering pad switch:
Recirculation/Fresh
2 to 2.9 V
ST1 (A7-2) - SGST (A715)
BR - G
Steering pad switch signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Steering pad switch: OFF
Above 4.6 V
ST2 (A7-1) - SGST (A715)
LG - G
Steering pad switch signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Steering pad switch:
AUTO
Below 0.3 V
ST2 (A7-1) - SGST (A715)
LG - G
Steering pad switch signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Steering pad switch:
TEMP+
0.8 to 1.5 V
ST2 (A7-1) - SGST (A715)
LG - G
Steering pad switch signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Steering pad switch:
TEMP-
2 to 2.9 V
ST2 (A7-1) - SGST (A715)
LG - G
Steering pad switch signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Steering pad switch: OFF
Above 4.6 V
SGST (A7-15) - Body
ground
G - Body ground
Ground for steering pad
switch
Always
Below 1 V
PSW (A7-6) - GND (A8-1)
R - W-B
Pressure switch signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Refrigerant pressure:
Normal
Below 1 V
PSW (A7-6) - GND (A8-1)
R - W-B
Pressure switch signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Refrigerant pressure:
More than 1,520 kPa (15.5
kgf/cm 2,220 psi)
10 to 14 V
RH (A7-9) - GND (A8-1)
R - W-B
Humidity sensor signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Room humidity: 40%
2V
RH (A7-9) - GND (A8-1)
R - W-B
Humidity sensor signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Room humidity: 60%
2.5 V
S5RM (A7-10) - GND (A81)
G - W-B
Power supply for humidity
sensor
Power switch ON (IG)
4.5 to 5.5 V
PTC (A7-17) - GND (A8-1)
P - W-B
PTC heater signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Temperature switch: Max.
HOT
Coolant temperature:
Below 55°C (131°F)
Blower switch: OFF
Below 1 V
PTC (A7-17) - GND (A8-1)
P - W-B
PTC heater signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Temperature switch: Max.
HOT
Coolant temperature:
Below 55°C (131°F)
Blower switch: LO
10 to 14 V
HT-1 (A7-26) - GND (A81)
BR - W-B
PTC heater signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Temperature switch: Max.
HOT
Coolant temperature:
Below 55°C (131°F)
Blower switch: OFF
Below 1 V
HT-1 (A7-26) - GND (A81)
BR - W-B
PTC heater signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Temperature switch: Max.
HOT
Coolant temperature:
Below 55°C (131°F)
Blower switch: LO
10 to 14 V
AC–33
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
HT-2 (A7-25) - GND (A81)
L - W-B
PTC heater signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Temperature switch: Max.
HOT
Coolant temperature:
Below 55°C (131°F)
Blower switch: OFF
Below 1 V
HT-2 (A7-25) - GND (A81)
L - W-B
PTC heater signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Temperature switch: Max.
HOT
Coolant temperature:
Below 55°C (131°F)
Blower switch: LO
10 to 14 V
IDH (A8-18) - GND (A8-1)
V - W-B
DC/DC converter signal
Power switch ON (IG)
(Voltage normal)
10 to 14 V
IDH (A8-18) - GND (A8-1)
V - W-B
DC/DC converter signal
Power switch ON (IG)
(Over voltage)
Below 1 V
(b) Using an oscilloscope, measure the waveform 1.
Waveform 1
2 V/DIV.
Item
Content
Symbols (Terminal No.)
BLW (A8-2) - GND (A8-1)
Tool Setting
2 V/DIV., 500 msec./DIV.
Condition
Power switch ON (IG), Blower switch
LO
HINT:
When the blower level is increased, the duty ratio
changes accordingly.
GND
500 msec./DIV.
I031456E18
AC
AC–34
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
CG
1.
DESCRIPTION
(a) Air conditioning system data and the Diagnostic
Trouble Codes (DTCs) can be read through the
Data Link Connector 3 (DLC3) of the vehicle. When
the system seems to be malfunctioning, use the
intelligent tester to check for malfunctions and
perform troubleshooting.
2.
CHECK DLC3
The vehicle's ECM uses the ISO 15765-4 for
communication protocol. The terminal arrangement of
the DLC3 complies with SAE J1962 and matches the
ISO 15765-4 format.
SG CANH SIL
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
BAT
9 10 1112131415 16
CANL
AC
E117124E04
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
SIL (7) - SG (5)
Bus "+" line
During transmission
Pulse generation
CG (4) - Body ground
Chassis ground
Always
Below 1Ω
SG (5) - Body ground
Signal ground
Always
Below 1Ω
BAT (16) - Body ground
Battery positive
Always
11 to 14 V
CANH (6) - CANL (14)
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Power switch OFF*
54 to 67 Ω
CANH (6) - Battery positive
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Power switch OFF*
1 MΩ or higher
CANH (6) - CG (4)
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Power switch OFF*
3 MΩ or higher
CANL (14) - Battery positive
LOW-level CAN bus line
Power switch OFF*
1 MΩ or higher
CANL (14) - CG (4)
LOW-level CAN bus line
Power switch OFF*
3 MΩ or higher
NOTICE:
*: Before measuring the resistance, leave the vehicle
as is for at least 1 minute and do not operate the
power switch, any other switches or the doors.
If the result is not as specified, the DLC3 may have a
malfunction. Repair or replace the harness and
connector.
HINT:
Connect the cable of the intelligent tester (with CAN
VIM) to the DLC3, turn the power switch ON (IG) and
attempt to use the tester. If the display indicates that a
communication error has occurred, there is a problem
either with the vehicle or with the tester.
• If communication is normal when the tester is
connected to another vehicle, inspect the DLC3 of the
original vehicle.
• If communication is still not possible when the tester
is connected to another vehicle, the problem may be
in the tester itself. Consult the Service Department
listed in the tester's instruction manual.
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
AC–35
DTC CHECK / CLEAR
Intelligent Tester
1.
DLC3
2.
CAN VIM
B127989E05
CHECK DTC
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and turn the
intelligent tester ON.
(c) Read the DTC by following the prompts on the
tester screen.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual for
further details.
CLEAR DTC
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and turn the
intelligent tester ON.
(c) Clear the DTC by following the prompts on the
tester screen.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual for
further details.
AC
AC–36
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
CHECK MODE PROCEDURE
1.
AC
LIST OF OPERATION METHODS
By operating each of the A/C control switches as shown
in the diagram below, it is possible to enter the diagnostic
check mode.
AC–37
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Turn power switch to the
ON (READY) position while
pressing AUTO and R/F
switches simultaneously.
If both AUTO switch and R/F
switches are not pressed
simultaneously.
Indicator Check
(continuous operation)
TEMP-
DTC Check
(Sensor Check)
(continuous operation)
Actuator Check
(continuous operation)
R/F
TEMP-
AUTO
Fr. DEF
Fr. DEF
TEMP-
DTC Check
(Sensor Check)
(step operation)
R/F
AUTO
R/F
Actuator Check
(step operation)
TEMP-
AUTO
Fr. DEF
Fr. DEF
Cancel check mode and start A/C control.
: Indicates steering switch operation
R/F: Recirculation / Fresh select switch
Fr. DEF: Front defogger switch
E125223E01
AC
AC–38
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
2.
INDICATOR CHECK
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) While pressing both the AUTO and R/F
(Recirculation/ Fresh) switches on the steering
switch, turn the power switch from OFF to ON
(READY).
E072827E01
(c) The indicator check is automatically performed
when activating panel diagnosis. Check that all
indicators and setting displays come on and go off 4
times at 1 second intervals.
Check that the buzzer sounds when the indicators
come on.
HINT:
The sensor check is automatically started when the
indicator check is completed.
(d) Push the "TEMP DOWN (-)" switch to finish panel
diagnosis.
2 sec.
1 sec.
ON
OFF
I036311E01
AC
AC–39
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST
1.
READ DATA LIST
HINT:
Using the intelligent tester's DATA LIST allows switch,
sensor, actuator and other item values to be read without
removing any parts. Reading the DATA LIST early in
troubleshooting is one way to save time.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and turn the
intelligent tester ON.
(c) Read the DATA LIST by following the prompts on
the tester.
Air conditioning amplifier
Item
Measurement Item /
Display (Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
ROOM TEMP
Room temperature sensor /
min.: -6.5°C (20.3°F)
max.: 57.25°C (135.05°F)
Actual room temperature is
displayed
Open in the circuit: -6.5°C
(20.3°F)
Short in the circuit: 57.25°C
(135.05°F)
AMBI TEMP SENS
Ambient temperature sensor /
min.: -23.3°C (-9.94°F)
max.: 65.95°C (150.71°F)
Actual ambient temperature is
displayed
Open in the circuit: -23.3°C (9.94°F)
Short: in the circuit: 65.95°C
(150.71°F)
EVAP TEMP
Evaporator temperature sensor /
min.: -29.7°C (-21.46°F)
max.: 59.55°C (139.19°F)
Actual evaporator temperature is
displayed
Open in the circuit: -29.7°C (21.46°F)
Short in the circuit: 59.55°C
(139.19°F)
SOLAR SENS-P
Solar sensor (Passenger side) /
min.: 0 max.: 255
Increases as brightness
increases
Open in the circuit: 0
Short in the circuit: 255
COOLANT TEMP
Engine coolant temperature /
min.: 1.3°C (34.34°F)
max.: 90.55°C (194.99°F)
Actual engine coolant
temperature is displayed while
the engine is warmed up
-
SET TEMP-D
Set temperature (Driver side) /
min.: 0 max.: 255
The same contents as a setting
temperature display part are
displayed
-
ESTIMATE TEMP-D
Estimated temperature (Driver
side) / min.: -358.4°C (-613.12°F)
max.: 358.4°C (677.12°F)
Damper is at "MAX. COOL":
-358.4°C (-613.12°F)
Damper is at "MAX. HOT":
358.4°C (677.12°F)
-
A/M DAMP POS-P
Air mix damper position
(Passenger side) / min.: -14%
max.: 113.5%
Damper is at "MAX. COOL":
-10.0%
Damper is at "MAX. HOT":
100.0% or 71.0%
-
A/O DAMP POS
Air outlet damper position /
min.: -14% max.: 113.5%
Damper is at "FACE": -10.0%
Damper is at "FACE/FOOT":
12.0%
Damper is at "FOOT" (Manual):
33.5% or 69.0%
Damper is at "FOOT" (Auto):
49.0% or 69.0 %
Damper is at "FACE/DEF": 69.0%
or 95.0%
Damper is at "DEF": 110.0%
Open in the circuit: 50.0%
A/I DAMP POS
Air inlet damper position /
min.: -14% max.: 113.5%
Damper is at
"RECIRCULATION": -1.0%
Damper is at "FRESH": 110.0%
Damper is at "HALFRECIRCULATION": 20.0 to
102.0%
Open in the circuit: 50.0%
AC
AC–40
AC
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Item
Measurement Item /
Display (Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
A/M DAMP TARG-P
Air mix damper target position
(Passenger side) /
min.: -14% max.: 113.5%
Damper is at "MAX. COOL": 10.0%
Damper is at "MAX. HOT":
100.0% or 71.0%
-
A/O DAMP TARG
Air outlet damper target position /
min.: -14% max.: 113.5%
Damper is at "FACE": -10.0%
Damper is at "FACE/FOOT":
12.0%
Damper is at "FOOT" (Manual):
33.5% or 69.0%
Damper is at "FOOT" (Auto):
49.0% or 69.0 %
Damper is at "FACE/DEF": 69.0%
or 95.0%
Damper is at "DEF": 110.0%
Open in the circuit: 50.0%
A/I DAMP TARG
Air inlet damper target position /
min.: -14% max.: 113.5%
Damper is at
"RECIRCULATION": -1.0%
Damper is at "FRESH": 110.0%
Damper is at "HALFRECIRCULATION": 20.0 to
102.0%
Open in the circuit: 50.0%
HAND FREE TEL
Handsfree telephone / OFF, ON
-
-
BLOWER LEVEL
Blower motor speed level /
min.: Level 0 max.: 31
Increases in the range between 0
and 31 as the speed increases
-
AMBI TEMP
Adjusted ambient temperature /
min.: -30.8°C (-23.44°F)
max.: 50.8°C (123.44°F)
-
-
SET TEMP SHIFT
Shift set temperature / +2C, +1C,
NORMAL, -1C, -2C
Customized value will be
displayed
-
AIR INLET MODE
Air inlet mode / AUTO, MANUAL
Customized value will be
displayed
-
COMPRESSOR MODE
Compressor mode / AUTO,
MANUAL
Customized value will be
displayed
-
COMPRS/DEF OPER
Compressor/DEF operation mode
/ LINK, NORMAL
Customized value will be
displayed
-
FOOT AIR LEAK
Foot air leak / ON, OFF
Customized value will be
displayed
-
AUTO BLOW UP
Foot/DEF automatic blower up
function / ON, OFF
Customized value will be
displayed
-
FOOT/DEF MODE
Foot/DEF auto mode / ON, OFF
Customized value will be
displayed
-
AMBIENT TMP SFT
Ambient temperature shift / +3C,
+2C, +1C, NORMAL, -1C, 2C, 3C
Customized value will be
displayed
-
DESTINATION
Destination/ DOMEST, USA,
EUROPE, AUSTRAL, MIDEAST,
NO INFO
Changes with destinations
-
DESTINATION
Destination/ DOMEST, USA,
EUROPE, AUSTRAL, MIDEAST,
NO INFO
Changes with destinations
-
HUMIDITY SENS
Humidity sensor /
min.: 0% max.: 100%
Actual room humidity is displayed
-
COMPRS SPD
Compressor speed /
min.: 0 rpm max.: 65,535 rpm
Displays actual rotation speed in
the range between 0 rpm and
7,500 rpm
-
COMPRS TARG SPD
Compressor target speed /
min.: 0 rpm max.: 65,535 rpm
Displays target rotation speed in
the range between 0 rpm and
7,500 rpm
-
#CODES
Number of trouble codes /
min.: 0 max.: 255
Number of DTCs will be displayed
-
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
2.
AC–41
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST
HINT:
Performing the intelligent tester's ACTIVE TEST allows
relays, the VSV, actuators and other items to be
operated without removing any parts. Performing the
ACTIVE TEST early in troubleshooting is one way to
save time. The DATA LIST can be displayed in the
ACTIVE TEST.
It is possible to display the DATA LIST on the intelligent
tester during the ACTIVE TEST.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and turn the
intelligent tester ON.
(c) Perform the ACTIVE TEST by following the prompts
on the tester.
Air conditioning amplifier
Item
Test Details / Display (Range)
Diagnostic Note
BLOWER MOTOR
Blower motor / min.: 0 max.: 31
-
AIR MIX DAMP-P
Air mix damper (Passenger side) /
min.: -14% max.: 113.5%
-
A/O MODE DAMP-D
Air outlet damper position (Driver side) /
min.: -14% max.: 113.5%
-
A/I DAMP-LINEAR
Air inlet damper position (linear) /
min.: -14% max.: 113.5%
-
COMPRS TARG SPD
Compressor target speed /
min.: 0 max.: 255
-
DEFOGGER RLY-R
Defogger relay (Rear) / OFF, ON
-
WATER PUMP RLY
Water pump / OFF, ON
-
ELECTRICAL FAN
Electrical fan / OFF, ON
-
DEFOGGER RLY-R
Defogger relay (Rear) / OFF, ON
-
A/C MAG CLUTCH
Magnetic Clutch Relay / OFF, ON
-
WATER PUMP RLY
Water pump / OFF, ON
-
ELECTRICAL FAN
Electrical fan / OFF, ON
-
AC
AC–42
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
HINT:
When the air conditioning system function properly, DTC
B1400/00 is output.
Air conditioning system
DTC No.
Trouble Area
Memory*4
See page
B1411*1
Room Temperature
Sensor Circuit
- Room temperature
sensor
- Wire harness between
cooler room temperature
sensor and air
conditioning amplifier
- Air conditioning amplifier
(8.5 min. or more)
AC-42
B1412*2
Ambient Temperature
Sensor Circuit
- Room temperature
sensor
- Wire harness between
ambient temperature
sensor and ECM
- ECM
- Multiplex communication
circuit
- Air conditioning amplifier
(8.5 min. or more)
AC-46
Evaporator Temperature
Sensor Circuit
- Evaporator temperature
sensor
- Wire harness between
evaporator temperature
sensor and air
conditioning amplifier
- Air conditioning amplifier
(8.5 min. or more)
AC-51
Solar Sensor Circuit
(Passenger Side)
- Solar sensor
- Wire harness between
solar sensor and air
conditioning amplifier or
body ECU
- Air conditioning amplifier
(8.5 min. or more)
AC-55
B1423
Pressure Switch Circuit
- Pressure switch
- Wire harness between
pressure switch and body
ground
- Multiplex communication
circuit
- Refrigerant pipe line
- Air conditioning amplifier
-
AC-59
B1431
Air Mix Damper Position
Sensor Circuit (Passenger
Side)
- Air mix control servo
motor (air mix damper
position sensor)
- Wire harness between
air mix control servo motor
and air conditioning
amplifier
- Air conditioning amplifier
(1 min. or more)
AC-63
B1432
Air Inlet Damper Position
Sensor Circuit
- Air inlet control servo
motor (air inlet damper
position sensor)
- Wire harness between
air inlet control servo
motor and air conditioning
amplifier
- Air conditioning amplifier
(1 min. or more)
AC-67
B1413
B1421*3
AC
Detection Item
AC–43
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
B1433
Air Outlet Damper Position
Sensor Circuit
- Air outlet control servo
motor (air outlet damper
position sensor)
- Wire harness between
air outlet control servo
motor and air conditioning
amplifier
- Air conditioning amplifier
(1 min. or more)
Memory*4
See page
AC-72
B1441
Air Mix Damper Control
Servo Motor Circuit
(Passenger Side)
- Air mix control servo
motor
- Wire harness between
air mix control servo motor
and air conditioning
amplifier
- Air conditioning amplifier
(15 sec.)
AC-77
B1442
Air Inlet Damper Control
Servo Motor Circuit
- Air inlet control servo
motor
- Wire harness between
air inlet control servo
motor and air conditioning
amplifier
- Air conditioning amplifier
(15 sec.)
AC-81
B1443
Air Outlet Damper Control
Servo Motor Circuit
- Air outlet control servo
motor
- Wire harness between
air outlet control servo
motor and air conditioning
amplifier
- Air conditioning amplifier
(15 sec.)
AC-85
B1462
Room Humidity Sensor
Circuit
- Room humidity sensor
(room temperature
sensor)
- Wire harness between
room humidity sensor
(room temperature
sensor) and air
conditioning amplifier
- Air conditioning amplifier
-
AC-89
B1471
A/C Inverter High Voltage
Power Resource System
Malfunction
- Hybrid control ECU
- A/C inverter (inverter with
converter)
-
AC-93
B1472
A/C Inverter High Voltage
Output System
Malfunction
- Hybrid control ECU
- Electric inverter
compressor (w/ motor
compressor)
- A/C inverter (inverter with
converter)
-
AC-96
B1473
A/C Inverter Start-up
Signal System Malfunction
- Wire harness between
hybrid control ECU and A/
C inverter (inverter with
converter)
- A/C inverter (inverter with
converter)
- Hybrid control ECU
-
AC-99
B1475
A/C Inverter Cooling /
Heating System
Malfunction
- A/C inverter (inverter with
converter)
-
AC-101
B1476
A/C Inverter Load System
Malfunction
- Volume of refrigerant
- Electric inverter
compressor (w/ motor
compressor)
- Cooling fan circuit
-
AC-102
B1477
A/C Inverter Low Voltage
Power Resource System
Malfunction
- A/C inverter (inverter with
converter)
-
AC-104
AC
AC–44
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DTC No.
B1498
P0AA6-611
Detection Item
Trouble Area
Memory*4
See page
Communication
Malfunction (A/C Inverter
Local)
- Wire harness between
hybrid control ECU and A/
C inverter (inverter with
converter)
- Hybrid control ECU
- A/C inverter (inverter with
converter)
-
AC-105
Hybrid Battery Voltage
System Isolation Fault
- Electric inverter
compressor (w/ motor
compressor)
- A/C inverter (inverter with
converter)
- Compressor oil
-
AC-107
HINT:
• *1: If the room temperature is approx. -18.6°C (-3.7 °F) or
lower, DTC B1411/11 may be output even though the
system is normal.
• *2: If the ambient temperature is approx. -52.9°C (-61.4°F)
or lower, a malfunction code may be output even though
the system is normal.
• *3: If the check is performed in a dark place, DTC B1421/
21 or B1424/24 (solar sensor circuit abnormal) could be
displayed.
• *4: The air conditioning amplifier memorizes the DTC of
the respective malfunction that has occurred for a period
of the time indicated in the brackets.
ACTUATOR CHECK
1.
1 sec.
1 sec.
ON
OFF
I036313E02
AC
ACTUATOR CHECK
(a) Start the engine to warm it up.
(b) Perform the indicator check.
(c) Push the R/F (Recirculation/Fresh) switch to
perform the actuator check when the sensor check
is started after the indicator check.
HINT:
Be sure to perform the actuator check with the
power switch ON (READY).
(d) As the actuator check (continuous) is repeated from
steps 0 to 9 at 1 second intervals, check the
temperature and airflow visually and by hand.
(e) If the steps are difficult to read because they change
automatically, push the "Fr. DEF" switch to display
the steps step by step so that they can be read
easily. The items are displayed step by step each
time the "Fr. DEF" switch is pushed.
HINT:
• The display blinks at 1 second intervals in the
step operation.
• The illustration indicates that code 4 is output.
Push the "TEMP-" switch to finish panel
diagnosis.
• Push the "AUTO" switch to enter the sensor
check mode.
AC–45
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Step No.
Display code
Conditions
Blower level
Air flow vent
Air inlet damper
Air mix damper
A/C compressor
revolution speed
(rpm)
1
0
0
FACE
(-10.0%)
FRESH
(110.0%)
"COOL" position
(-10.0%)
0
2
1
1
FACE
(-10.0%)
FRESH
(110.0%)
"COOL" position
(-10.0%)
0
3
2
17
FACE
(-10.0%)
FRESH
(110.0%)
"COOL" position
(-10.0%)
7,500
4
3
17
FACE
(-10.0%)
RECIRCULATION
(-1.0%)
"COOL" position
(-10.0%)
7,500
5
4
17
B/L
(12%)
RECIRCULATION
(-1.0%)
"COOL" / "HOT"
(50.0% opened)
4,500
6
5
17
FOOT
(49%)
RECIRCULATION
(-1.0%)
"COOL" / "HOT"
(65.0% opened)
4,500
7
6
17
FOOT
(49%)
RECIRCULATION
(-1.0%)
"HOT " position
(100.0%)
4,500
8
7
17
F/D
(69%)
RECIRCULATION
(-1.0%)
"COOL" / "HOT"
(65.0% opened)
4,500
9
8
17
F/D
(95%)
RECIRCULATION
(-1.0%)
"COOL" / "HOT"
(90.0% opened)
4,500
10
9
31
DEF
(110.0%)
RECIRCULATION
(-1.0%)
"COOL" / "HOT"
(50.0% opened)
4,500
AC
AC–46
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DTC
B1411
Room Temperature Sensor Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The room temperature sensor is installed in the instrument panel to detect the room temperature and
control the heater and air conditioner "AUTO" function. The resistance of the room temperature sensor
changes in accordance with the room temperature. As the temperature decreases, the resistance
increases. As the temperature increases, the resistance decreases.
The air conditioning amplifier applies voltage (5 V) to the room temperature sensor and reads voltage
changes as the resistance of the room temperature sensor changes. This sensor also sends appropriate
signals to the air conditioning amplifier. The room temperature sensor is integrated with the room humidity
sensor.
DTC No.
Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1411
Open or short in room temperature sensor
circuit
•
•
•
Room temperature sensor
Wire harness between cooler room
temperature sensor and air conditioning
amplifier
Air conditioning amplifier
WIRING DIAGRAM
Room Temperature Sensor
Air Conditioning Amplifier
THR
Room Humidity
Sensor Area
Room Temperature
Sensor Area
GND
VO
S5
TR
SGTR
RH
S5RM
E125205E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (ROOM TEMP)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and push the intelligent
tester main switch ON.
AC
AC–47
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
(c) Select the item below in the DATA LIST, and read the
display on the intelligent tester.
Air conditioning amplifier
Item
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
ROOM TEMP
Room temperature sensor / Open
in the circuit:
min.: -6.5°C (20.3°F)
max.: 57.25°C (135.05°F)
Actual room temperature is
displayed
Open in the circuit: -6.5°C
(20.3°F)
Short in the circuit: 57.25°C
(135.05°F)
OK:
The display is as specified in the normal condition.
Result
Result
Proceed to
NG
A
OK (Checking from the PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE)
B
OK (Checking from the DTC)
C
B
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
C
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
A
2
CHECK AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER (TR VOLTAGE)
TR
A7
SGTR
(a) Remove the air conditioning amplifier with connectors
still connected.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
A7-8 (TR) - A7-22
(SGTR)
Power switch ON (IG) at
25°C (77°F)
1.8 to 2.2 V
A7-8 (TR) - A7-22
(SGTR)
Power switch ON (IG) at
40°C (104°F)
1.2 to 1.6 V
I041186E01
A
HINT:
As the temperature increases, the voltage decreases.
Result
Result
Proceed to
NG
A
OK (Checking from the PROBLEM
SYMPTOMS TABLE)
B
OK (Checking from the DTC)
C
B
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
C
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
AC
AC–48
3
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECT ROOM TEMPERATURE SENSOR
(a) Remove the room temperature sensor.
(b) Measure the resistance of the sensor.
Standard resistance
GND
Sensor Area
THR
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1 (THR) - 2 (GND)
10°C (50°F)
3.00 to 3.73 kΩ
1 (THR) - 2 (GND)
15°C (59°F)
2.45 to 2.88 kΩ
1 (THR) - 2 (GND)
20°C (68°F)
1.95 to 2.30 kΩ
1 (THR) - 2 (GND)
25°C (77°F)
1.60 to 1.80 kΩ
1 (THR) - 2 (GND)
30°C (86°F)
1.28 to 1.47 kΩ
1 (THR) - 2 (GND)
35°C (95°F)
1.00 to 1.22 kΩ
Resistance (kΩ)
1 (THR) - 2 (GND)
40°C (104°F)
0.80 to 1.00 kΩ
1 (THR) - 2 (GND)
45°C (113°F)
0.65 to 0.85 kΩ
1 (THR) - 2 (GND)
50°C (122°F)
0.50 to 0.70 kΩ
q%
q(
Temperature
1 (THR) - 2 (GND)
55°C (131°F)
0.44 to 0.60 kΩ
1 (THR) - 2 (GND)
60°C (140°F)
0.36 to 0.50 kΩ
NOTICE:
• Even slightly touching the sensor may change the
resistance value. Be sure to hold the connector of
the sensor.
• When measuring, the sensor temperature must be
the same as the ambient temperature.
HINT:
As the temperature increases, the resistance decreases
(see the graph).
E127529E01
NG
OK
AC
REPLACE ROOM TEMPERATURE SENSOR
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
4
AC–49
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ROOM TEMPERATURE SENSOR - AIR CONDITIONING
AMPLIFIER)
(a) Disconnect the A9 sensor connector.
(b) Disconnect the A7 amplifier connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Room Temperature Sensor
THR
A9
GND
Air Conditioning Amplifier
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A7-8 (TR) - A9-1 (THR)
Below 1 Ω
A7-22 (SGTR) - A9-2 (GND)
Below 1 Ω
A7-8 (TR) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A7-22 (SGTR) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
A7
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
TR
SGTR
E125230E01
OK
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
AC
AC–50
DTC
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
B1412
Ambient Temperature Sensor Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The ambient temperature sensor is installed in the front part of the condenser to detect the ambient
temperature and control the heater and air conditioner "AUTO" function. The sensor connected to the
ECM detects fluctuation in the ambient temperature that is used for controlling the room temperature. The
sensor sends a signal to the air conditioning amplifier via the ECM. The resistance of the ambient
temperature sensor changes in accordance with the ambient temperature. As the temperature decreases,
the resistance increases. As the temperature increases, the resistance decreases.
The ECM applies voltage (5 V) to the ambient temperature sensor and reads voltage changes as the
resistance of the ambient temperature sensor changes. The ECM sends the read signal to the air
conditioning amplifier via CAN and body multiplex communications.
DTC No.
Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1412
Open or short in ambient temperature sensor
circuit
•
•
•
•
•
Ambient temperature sensor
Wire harness between ambient
temperature sensor and ECM
ECM
Multiplex communication circuit
Air conditioning amplifier
WIRING DIAGRAM
Ambient Temperature Sensor
ECM
TAM
E2
See Multiplex Communication System
(CAN Bus)
CANH
CANL
Air Conditioning Amplifier
See Multiplex Communication System
(BEAN Bus)
AC
MPX+
MPX2+
E125206E01
AC–51
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (AMBI TEMP SENS)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and push the intelligent
tester main switch ON.
(c) Select the item below in the DATA LIST, and read the
display on the intelligent tester.
Air conditioning amplifier
Item
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
AMBI TEMP SENS
Ambient temperature sensor /
min.: -23.3°C (-9.94°F)
max.: 65.95°C (150.71°F)
Actual ambient temperature is
displayed
Open in the circuit: -23.3°C (9.94°F)
Short: in the circuit: 65.95°C
(150.71°F)
OK:
The display is as specified in the normal condition.
Result
Result
Proceed to
NG
A
OK (Checking from the PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE)
B
OK (Checking from the DTC)
C
B
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
C
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
A
2
CHECK ECM (TAM VOLTAGE)
E4
E5
E7
E2
E6
TAM
I036365E01
(a) Remove the ECM with connectors still connected.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
E7-21 (TAM) - E4-28 (E2)
Power switch ON (IG) at
25°C (77°F)
1.8 to 2.2 V
AC
AC–52
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
E7-21 (TAM) - E4-28 (E2)
Power switch ON (IG) at
40°C (104°F)
1.2 to 1.6 V
HINT:
As the temperature increases, the voltage decreases.
Result
A
AC
Result
Proceed to
NG
A
OK (Checking from the PROBLEM
SYMPTOMS TABLE)
B
OK (Checking from the DTC)
C
B
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
C
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
AC–53
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
3
INSPECT AMBIENT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
(a) Remove the ambient temperature sensor.
(b) Measure the resistance of the sensor.
Standard resistance
Sensor Area
Resistance (kΩ)
3.5
3.0
2.5
2.0
1.5
1.0
0.5
(50)
Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
10°C (50°F)
3.00 to 3.73 kΩ
1-2
15°C (59°F)
2.45 to 2.88 kΩ
1-2
20°C (68°F)
1.95 to 2.30 kΩ
1-2
25°C (77°F)
1.60 to 1.80 kΩ
1-2
30°C (86°F)
1.28 to 1.47 kΩ
1-2
35°C (95°F)
1.00 to 1.22 kΩ
1-2
40°C (104°F)
0.80 to 1.00 kΩ
1-2
45°C (113°F)
0.65 to 0.85 kΩ
1-2
50°C (122°F)
0.50 to 0.70 kΩ
1-2
55°C (131°F)
0.44 to 0.60 kΩ
1-2
60°C (140°F)
0.36 to 0.50 kΩ
NOTICE:
• Even slightly touching the sensor may change the
resistance value. Be sure to hold the connector of
the sensor.
• When measuring, the sensor temperature must be
the same as the ambient temperature.
HINT:
As the temperature increases, the resistance decreases
(see the graph).
4.0
0.0
10
Tester Connection
NG
20
(68)
30
40
50 q%
60
q(
REPLACE AMBIENT TEMPERATURE
SENSOR
(86) (104) (122) (140)
Temperature °C (°F)
E114516E12
OK
AC
AC–54
4
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (AMBIENT TEMPERATURE SENSOR - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the A6 sensor connector.
(b) Disconnect the E4 and E7 ECM connectors.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Ambient Temperature Sensor
Tester Connection
A6
ECM
E4
E7-21 (TAM) - A6-2
Below 1 Ω
E4-28 (E2) - A6-1
Below 1 Ω
E7-21 (TAM) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
E4-28 (E2) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
E7
E2
TAM
I036366E01
OK
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
AC
Specified Condition
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
AC–55
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DTC
B1413
Evaporator Temperature Sensor Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The evaporator temperature sensor is installed on the evaporator in the air conditioner unit to detect the
cooled air temperature that has passed through the evaporator and control the air conditioning. It sends
appropriate signals to the air conditioning amplifier. The resistance of the evaporator temperature sensor
changes in accordance with the cooled air temperature that has passed through the evaporator. As the
temperature decreases, the resistance increases. As the temperature increases, the resistance
decreases.
The air conditioning amplifier applies voltage (5 V) to the evaporator temperature sensor and reads
voltage changes as the resistance of the evaporator temperature sensor changes. This sensor is used for
frost prevention.
DTC No.
Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1413
Open or short in evaporator temperature
sensor circuit.
•
•
•
Evaporator temperature sensor
Wire harness between evaporator
temperature sensor and air conditioning
amplifier
Air conditioning amplifier
WIRING DIAGRAM
Evaporator Temperature Sensor
Air Conditioning Amplifier
TE
SGTE
E125207E02
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (EVAP TEMP)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and push the intelligent
tester main switch ON.
(c) Select the item below in the DATA LIST, and read the
display on the intelligent tester.
Air conditioning amplifier
Item
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
EVAP TEMP
Evaporator temperature sensor /
min.: -29.7°C (-21.46°F)
max.: 59.55°C (139.19°F)
Actual evaporator temperature is
displayed
Open in the circuit: -29.7°C (21.46°F)
Short in the circuit: 59.55°C
(139.19°F)
AC
AC–56
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
OK:
The display is as specified in the normal condition.
Result
Result
Proceed to
NG
A
OK (Checking from the PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE)
B
OK (Checking from the DTC)
C
B
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
C
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
A
2
CHECK AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER (TE VOLTAGE)
(a) Remove the air conditioning amplifier with connectors
still connected.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
A7
SGTE
A
AC
TE
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
A7-7 (TE) - A7-5 (SGTE)
Power switch ON (IG) at
0 °C (32°F)
2.0 to 2.4 V
A7-7 (TE) - A7-5 (SGTE)
Power switch ON (IG) at
15°C (59°F)
1.4 to 1.8 V
I041186E02
HINT:
As the temperature increases, the voltage decreases.
Result
Result
Proceed to
NG
A
OK (Checking from the PROBLEM
SYMPTOMS TABLE)
B
OK (Checking from the DTC)
C
B
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
C
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
AC–57
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
3
INSPECT EVAPORATOR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
(a) Remove the evaporator temperature sensor.
(b) Measure the resistance of the sensor.
Standard resistance
Evaporator
Evaporator Thermistor
Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
-10°C (14°F)
7.30 to 9.10 kΩ
1-2
-5°C (23°F)
5.65 to 6.95 kΩ
1-2
0°C (32°F)
4.40 to 5.35 kΩ
1-2
5°C (41°F)
3.40 to 4.15 kΩ
1-2
10°C (50°F)
2.70 to 3.25 kΩ
1-2
15°C (59°F)
2.14 to 2.58 kΩ
1-2
20°C (68°F)
1.71 to 2.05 kΩ
1-2
25°C (77°F)
1.38 to 1.64 kΩ
1-2
30°C (86°F)
1.11 to 1.32 kΩ
NOTICE:
• Even slightly touching the sensor may change the
resistance value. Be sure to hold the connector of
the sensor.
• When measuring, the sensor temperature must be
the same as the ambient temperature.
HINT:
As the temperature increases, the resistance decrease
(see the graph).
Sensor Area
Evaporator Thermistor
Resistance (kΩ)
10.0
9.0
8.0
7.0
6.0
5.0
4.0
3.0
2.0
1.0
0.0
㧙
-10
(14)
Tester Connection
NG
0
(32)
20
10
(68)
(50)
Temperature °C (°F)
REPLACE EVAPORATOR TEMPERATURE
SENSOR
30
q%
q(
(86)
E115010E15
OK
AC
AC–58
4
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (EVAPORATOR TEMPERATURE SENSOR - AIR CONDITIONING
AMPLIFIER)
Wire Harness Side
Evaporator Temperature Sensor
A11
Air Conditioning Amplifier
(a) Disconnect the A11 sensor connector.
(b) Disconnect the A7 amplifier connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A7-7 (TE) - A11-2
Below 1 Ω
A7-5 (SGTE) - A11-1
Below 1 Ω
A7-7 (TE) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A7-5 (SGTE) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
A7
TE
SGTE
E125231E01
OK
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
AC
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DTC
B1421
AC–59
Solar Sensor Circuit (Passenger Side)
DESCRIPTION
Resistance of photodiode
High
Low
Weak
Strong
Strength of solar radiation
E109314E08
The solar sensor is installed in the upper part of the instrument panel to detect the amount of solar
radiation with a photodiode to control the heater and air conditioner "AUTO" function. It sends appropriate
signals to the air conditioning amplifier. The output voltage of the solar sensor changes in accordance with
the amount of solar radiation. As the amount increases, the voltage increases. As the amount decreases,
the voltage decreases. The air conditioning amplifier reads voltage output from the solar sensor.
DTC No.
Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1421
Open or short in solar sensor circuit circuit.
(If the check is performed in a dark place,
DTC B1421 may be displayed.)
•
•
•
Solar sensor
Wire harness between solar sensor and
air conditioning amplifier or body ECU
Air conditioning amplifier
WIRING DIAGRAM
Air Conditioning Amplifier
Solar Sensor
S5TS
TS
AC
E125208E01
AC–60
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (SOLAR SENS-P)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and push the intelligent
tester main switch ON.
(c) Select the item below in the DATA LIST, and read the
display on the intelligent tester.
Air conditioning amplifier
Item
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
SOLAR SENS-P
Solar sensor (Passenger side) /
min.: 0 max.: 255
Increases as brightness
increases
Open in the circuit: 0
Short in the circuit: 255
OK:
The display is as specified in the normal condition.
Result
Result
Proceed to
NG
A
OK (Checking from the PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE)
B
OK (Checking from the DTC)
C
B
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
C
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
A
2
CHECK AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER (TS VOLTAGE)
(a) Remove the air conditioning amplifier with connectors
still connected.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
A7
S5TS
AC
TS
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
A7-12 (S5TS) - A7-21
(TS)
Power switch ON (IG)
0.8 to 4.3 V
HINT:
• As the inspection light is moved away from the
sensor, the voltage increases.
• As the inspection light is moved closer to the sensor,
the voltage decreases.
• Use an incandescent light for inspection. Bring it
within 30 cm (11.8 in.) of the solar sensor.
Result
I041186E03
Result
Proceed to
NG
A
OK (Checking from the PROBLEM
SYMPTOMS TABLE)
B
OK (Checking from the DTC)
C
AC–61
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
B
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
C
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
A
3
INSPECT SOLAR SENSOR
(a) Remove the solar sensor.
(b) Measure the resistance of the sensor.
• Connect the ohmmeter's positive (+) lead to terminal
2 and negative (-) lead to terminal 1 of the solar
sensor.
Standard resistance
2
1
E072857E04
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified condition
1-2
Sensor is subject to
electric light
Except ∞ Ω
1-2
Sensor is covered with
a cloth
∞ Ω (No continuity)
NOTICE:
The connection procedure for using a digital tester
such as an TOYOTA electrical tester is shown above.
When using an analog tester, connect the positive
(+) lead to terminal 1 and negative (-) lead to terminal
2 of the solar sensor.
HINT:
• As the inspection light is moved away from the
sensor, the resistance increases.
• Use an incandescent light for inspection. Bring it
within 30 cm (11.8 in.) of the solar sensor.
NG
REPLACE SOLAR SENSOR
OK
AC
AC–62
4
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SOLAR SENSOR - AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER)
(a) Disconnect the A10 solar sensor connector.
(b) Disconnect the A7 amplifier connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Solar Sensor
A10
Air Conditioning Amplifier
Specified Condition
A7-12 (S5TS) - A10-1
Below 1 Ω
A7-21 (TS) - A10-2
Below 1 Ω
A7-12 (S5TS) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A7-21 (TS) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
A7
S5TS
Tester Connection
TS
E125231E02
OK
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
AC
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DTC
B1423
AC–63
Pressure Switch Circuit
DESCRIPTION
Low-pressure Side
OFF (10 kΩ or higher)
High-pressure Side
ON (Below 1.0 Ω)
196 kPa
(2.0 kgf/cm2, 28 psi)
3,140 kPa
(32.0 kgf/cm2, 455 psi)
OFF (10 kΩ or higher)
E113418E11
The pressure switch to detect the refrigerant pressure is located in the sight glass side of the pipe on the
high-pressure side. This DTC is output when the refrigerant pressure is either significantly low (below 196
kPa (2.0 kgf/cm2, 28 psi) or significantly high (over 3,140 kPa (32.0 kgf/cm2, 455 psi). Then the pressure
switch sends appropriate signals to the air conditioning amplifier. The pressure switch has built-in
switches to detect high and low pressure and is turned off when either is determined to be defective. The
air conditioning amplifier continuously monitors the pressure switch signal after the power switch is turned
ON (IG). It stops compressor control and outputs the DTC when it detects the signal indicating that the
switch is turned OFF.
DTC No.
Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1423
When either condition below is met:
• Open in pressure sensor circuit.
• Abnormal refrigerant pressure:
•
•
Below 196 kPa (2.0 kgf/cm2, 28 psi)
Over 3,140 kPa (32.0 kgf/cm2, 455 psi)
•
•
•
Pressure switch
Wire harness between pressure switch
and body ground
Multiplex communication circuit
Refrigerant pipe line
Air conditioning amplifier
AC
AC–64
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Air Conditioning Amplifier
Pressure Switch
PSW
E125209E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK REFRIGERANT PRESSURE
(a) Set the manifold gauge.
(b) Read the manifold gauge pressure when these
conditions are established.
Test conditions:
• Temperature at the air inlet with the switch set at
RECIRC is 30 to 35°C (86 to 95°F)
• Power switch ON (IG)
• Blower speed control switch at "HI" position
• Temperature control dial at "COOL" position
• Air conditioning switch ON
• Fully open doors
Standard pressure:
Pressure on high pressure side:
1.37 to 1.57 MPa (13.9 to 16.0 kgf/cm2, 198 to 228
psi)
HINT:
If the refrigerant pressure is below 196 kPa (2.0 kgf/cm2,
28 psi), the refrigerant amount in the air conditioning
cycle may have decreased significantly for reasons such
as a gas leakage.
NG
AC
INSPECT AND REPAIR AIR CONDITIONING
CYCLE
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
AC–65
OK
2
CHECK AIR CONDITIONING OPERATION
Wire Harness Side
Pressure Switch
P1
I040669E01
(a) Disconnect the P1 pressure switch connector.
(b) Connect terminals 1 and 4 of the connector of the
pressure switch on the vehicle wire harness side using a
service wire.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Turn the air conditioning switch ON and check that the
compressor is operated.
(e) Check that the compressor is not operated when
disconnecting terminals 1 and 4 (that were connected in
the prior step).
OK:
Terminals 1 and 4 connected: the compressor is
operated
Terminals 1 and 4 disconnected: the compressor is
not operated
OK
REPLACE PRESSURE SWITCH
NG
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (PRESSURE SWITCH - AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER AND
BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the P1 pressure switch connector.
(b) Disconnect the A7 amplifier connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Pressure Switch
P1
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A7-6 (PSW) - P1-4
Below 1 Ω
P1-1 - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
A7-6 (PSW) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
Result
Air Conditioning Amplifier
Result
A7
NG
A
OK (Checking from the PROBLEM
SYMPTOMS TABLE)
B
OK (Checking from the DTC)
C
A
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
B
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
PSW
E125232E01
Proceed to
AC
AC–66
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
C
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
AC
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DTC
B1431
AC–67
Air Mix Damper Position Sensor Circuit (Passenger Side)
DESCRIPTION
Voltage (V)
4
1
0
100%
Damper opening angle
E109300E21
This sensor detects the position of the air mix control servo motor (air mix damper) and sends the
appropriate signals to the air conditioning amplifier. The position sensor is built into the air mix control
servo motor. The position sensor resistance changes as the air mix control servo motor arm moves.
It outputs voltage (5 V) that is input to terminal 1 (VZ) and terminal 3 (PT) via the variable resistor, and
then to the air conditioning amplifier. The air conditioning amplifier reads the arm position with the input
voltage from the position sensor.
DTC No.
Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1431
Open or short in power source circuit in air
mix damper position sensor circuit.
•
•
•
Air mix control servo motor (air mix
damper position sensor)
Wire harness between air mix control
servo motor and air conditioning amplifier
Air conditioning amplifier
AC
AC–68
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Air Conditioning Amplifier
Air Mix Control Servo Motor
PT
TP
GND
SGTP
VZ
S5TP
E125210E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (A/M DAMP POS-P, TARG-P)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and push the intelligent
tester main switch ON.
(c) Select the item below in the DATA LIST, and read the
display on the intelligent tester.
Air conditioning amplifier
Item
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
A/M DAMP POS-P
Air mix damper position
(Passenger side) / min.: -14%
max.: 113.5%
Damper is at "MAX. COOL": 10.0%
Damper is at "MAX. HOT":
100.0% or 71.0%
-
A/M DAMP TARG-P
Air mix damper target position
(Passenger side) / min.: -14%
max.: 113.5%
Damper is at "MAX. COOL": 10.0%
Damper is at "MAX. HOT":
100.0% or 71.0%
-
OK:
The displayed is as specified in the normal
condition.
Result
AC
Result
Proceed to
NG
A
OK (Checking from the PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE)
B
OK (Checking from the DTC)
C
AC–69
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
B
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
C
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
A
2
CHECK AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER (TP VOLTAGE)
(a) Remove the air conditioning amplifier with its connectors
still connected.
(b) Change the set temperature to activate the air mix servo
motor.
(c) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
A7
SGTP
TP
I041186E05
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
A7-20 (TP) - A7-14
(SGTP)
Power switch ON (IG)
MAX. HOT position
0.97 to 1.03 V
A7-20 (TP) - A7-14
(SGTP)
Power switch ON (IG)
MAX. COOL position
3.97 to 4.03 V
HINT:
As the set temperature increases, the voltage decreases
gradually without interruption.
Result
Result
Proceed to
NG
A
OK (Checking from the PROBLEM
SYMPTOMS TABLE)
B
OK (Checking from the DTC)
C
B
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
C
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
A
3
INSPECT AIR MIX CONTROL SERVO MOTOR
(a) Remove the air mix control servo motor.
(b) Measure the resistance of the servo motor.
Standard resistance
PT
GND
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A15-1 (VZ) - A15-2 (GND)
4.2 to 7.8 kΩ
VZ
E068754E01
AC
AC–70
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
(c) Measure the resistance of the servo motor.
Standard resistance
MAX. HOT
MAX. COOL
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
A15-3 (PT) - A15-2
(GND)
MAX. COOL Position
3.6 to 6.7 kΩ
A15-3 (PT) - A15-2
(GND)
MAX. HOT Position
0.8 to 1.6 kΩ
HINT:
• Refer to the operation procedure for air mix control servo
motor (see page AC-83).
• As the air mix control servo motor moves from the COOL
position to HOT position, the resistance decreases
gradually without interruption.
Resistance (kΩ)
3.6 to 6.7
Arm position
NG
REPLACE AIR MIX CONTROL SERVO
MOTOR
0.8 to 1.6
MAX. COOL
MAX. HOT
E127530E01
OK
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (AIR MIX CONTROL SERVO MOTOR - AIR CONDITIONING
AMPLIFIER)
Wire Harness Side
Air Mix Control Servo Motor
VZ
A15
GND
(a) Disconnect the A15 servo connector.
(b) Disconnect the A7 amplifier connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
PT
Air Conditioning Amplifier
A7
A7-20 (TP) - A15-3 (PT)
Below 1 Ω
A7-14 (SGTP) - A15-2 (GND
Below 1 Ω
A7-13 (S5TP) - A15-1 (VZ)
Below 1 Ω
A7-20 (TP) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A7-14 (SGTP) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A7-13 (S5TP) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
SGTP
S5TP
Specified Condition
TP
E125233E03
OK
AC
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DTC
B1432
AC–71
Air Inlet Damper Position Sensor Circuit
DESCRIPTION
Voltage (V)
4
1
0
100%
Damper opening angle
E109300E19
This sensor detects the position of the air inlet control servo motor and sends the appropriate signals to
the air conditioning amplifier. The position sensor is built into the air inlet control servo motor.
The position sensor's resistance changes as the air inlet control servo motor arm moves.
It outputs voltage (5 V) that is input to terminal 3 (VZ) and terminal 3 (PT) via the variable resistor, and
then to the air conditioning amplifier. The air conditioning amplifier reads the arm position with the input
voltage from the position sensor.
DTC No.
Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1432
Open or short in power source circuit in air
inlet damper position sensor circuit.
•
•
•
Air inlet control servo motor (air inlet
damper position sensor)
Wire harness between air inlet control
servo motor and air conditioning amplifier
Air conditioning amplifier
AC
AC–72
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Air Conditioning Amplifier
Air Inlet Control Servo Motor
PT
TPI
GND
SGTPI
VZ
S5TPI
E125210E04
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (A/I DAMP POS, TARG)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and push the intelligent
tester main switch ON.
(c) Select the item below in the DATA LIST, and read the
display on the intelligent tester.
Air conditioning amplifier
Item
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
A/I DAMP POS
Air inlet damper position /
min.: -14% max.: 113.5%
Damper is at
"RECIRCULATION": -1.0%
Damper is at "FRESH": 110.0%
Damper is at "HALFRECIRCULATION": 20.0 to
102.0%
Open in the circuit: 50.0%
A/I DAMP TARG
Air inlet damper target position /
min.: -14% max.: 113.5%
Damper is at
"RECIRCULATION": -1.0%
Damper is at "FRESH": 110.0%
Damper is at "HALFRECIRCULATION": 20.0 to
102.0%
Open in the circuit: 50.0%
OK:
The displayed is as specified in the normal
condition.
Result
AC
Result
Proceed to
NG
A
OK (Checking from the PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE)
B
AC–73
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Result
Proceed to
OK (Checking from the DTC)
C
B
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
C
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
A
2
CHECK AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER (TPI VOLTAGE)
(a) Remove the air conditioning amplifier with connectors
still connected.
(b) Change the set REC / FRS to activate the air inlet servo
motor.
(c) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
A7
SGTPI
TPI
I041186E06
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
A7-19 (TPI) - A7-4
(SGTPI)
Power switch ON (IG)
RECIRC position
3.5 to 4.5 V
A7-19 (TPI) - A7-4
(SGTPI)
Power switch ON (IG)
FRESH position
0.5 to 1.8 V
HINT:
As the air inlet servo motor is moved from REC position
to FRS position, the voltage decreases gradually without
interruption.
Result
Result
Proceed to
NG
A
OK (Checking from the PROBLEM
SYMPTOMS TABLE)
B
OK (Checking from the DTC)
C
B
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
C
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
A
AC
AC–74
3
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECT AIR INLET CONTROL SERVO MOTOR
(a) Remove the air inlet control servo motor.
(b) Measure the resistance of the servo motor.
Standard resistance
PT
GND
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A14-1 (VZ) - A14-2 (GND)
4.2 to 7.8 kΩ
VZ
E068754E02
RECIRCULATION
FRESH
3.4 to 6.2
Arm position
0.6 to 1.1
FRS
E127531E01
OK
AC
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
A14-3 (PT) - A14-2
(GND)
RECIRCULATION
position
3.4 to 6.2 kΩ
A14-3 (PT) - A14-2
(GND)
FRESH position
0.6 to 1.1 kΩ
HINT:
• Refer to the operation procedure of the air inlet
control servo motor (see page AC-87).
• As the air inlet control servo motor moves from
FRESH position to RECIRCULATION position, the
resistance decreases gradually without interruption.
Resistance (kΩ)
REC
(c) Measure the resistance of the servo motor.
Standard resistance
NG
REPLACE AIR INLET CONTROL SERVO
MOTOR
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
4
AC–75
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (AIR INLET CONTROL SERVO MOTOR - AIR CONDITIONING
AMPLIFIER)
Wire Harness Side
Air Inlet Control Servo Motor
VZ
A14
GND
PT
Air Conditioning Amplifier
A7
(a) Disconnect the A14 servo connector.
(b) Disconnect the A7 amplifier connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A7-19 (TPI) - A14-3 (PT)
Below 1 Ω
A7-4 (SGTPI) - A14-2 (GND)
Below 1 Ω
A7-3 (S5TPI) - A14-1 (VZ)
Below 1 Ω
A7-19 (TPI) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A7-4 (SGTPI) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A7-3 (S5TPI) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
SGTPI
S5TPI
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
TPI
E125233E01
OK
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
AC
AC–76
DTC
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
B1433
Air Outlet Damper Position Sensor Circuit
DESCRIPTION
Voltage (V)
4
1
0
100%
Damper opening angle
E109300E22
This sensor detects the position of the air outlet control servo motor and sends the appropriate signals to
the air conditioning amplifier. The position sensor is built into the air outlet control servo motor. The
potentiometer's resistance changes as the air outlet control servo motor arm moves.
It outputs voltage (5 V) that is input to terminal 1 (VZ) and terminal 3 (PT) via the variable resistor, and
then to the air conditioning amplifier. The air conditioning amplifier reads the arm position with the input
voltage from the potentiometer.
DTC No.
Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1433
Open or short in power source circuit in air
outlet damper position sensor circuit.
•
•
•
AC
Air outlet control servo motor (air outlet
damper position sensor)
Wire harness between air outlet control
servo motor and air conditioning amplifier
Air conditioning amplifier
AC–77
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Air Conditioning Amplifier
Air Outlet Control Servo Motor
PT
TPM
GND
SGTPM
VZ
S5TPM
E125210E03
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (A/O DAMP POS, TARG)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and push the intelligent
tester main switch ON.
(c) Select the items below in the DATA LIST, and read the
displays on the intelligent tester.
Air conditioning amplifier
Item
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
A/O DAMP POS
Air outlet damper position /
min.: -14% max.: 113.5%
Damper is at "FACE": -10.0%
Damper is at "FACE/FOOT":
12.0%
Damper is at "FOOT" (Manual):
33.5% or 69.0%
Damper is at "FOOT" (Auto):
49.0% or 69.0%
Damper is at "FACE/DEF": 69.0%
or 95.0%
Damper is at "DEF": 110.0%
Open in the circuit: 50.0%
A/O DAMP TARG
Air outlet damper target position /
min.: -14% max.: 113.5%
Damper is at "FACE": -10.0%
Damper is at "FACE/FOOT":
12.0%
Damper is at "FOOT" (Manual):
33.5% or 69.0%
Damper is at "FOOT" (Auto):
49.0% or 69.0 %
Damper is at "FACE/DEF": 69.0%
or 95.0%
Damper is at "DEF": 110.0%
Open in the circuit: 50.0%
AC
AC–78
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
OK:
The displayed is as specified in the normal
condition.
Result
Result
Proceed to
NG
A
OK (Checking from the PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE)
B
OK (Checking from the DTC)
C
B
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
C
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
A
2
CHECK AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER (TPM VOLTAGE)
(a) Remove the air condition amplifier with connectors still
connected.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
A7
SGTPM
A
AC
TPM I041186E08
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
A7-18 (TPM) - A7-23
(SGTPM)
Power switch ON (IG)
FACE position
3.97 to 4.07 V
A7-18 (TPM) - A7-23
(SGTPM)
Power switch ON (IG)
DEF position
0.97 to 1.03 V
HINT:
As the air outlet servo motor is moved from the FACE
position to the DEF position, the voltage decreases
gradually without interruption.
Result
Result
Proceed to
NG
A
OK (Checking from the PROBLEM
SYMPTOMS TABLE)
B
OK (Checking from the DTC)
C
B
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
C
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
AC–79
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
3
INSPECT AIR OUTLET CONTROL SERVO MOTOR
(a) Remove the air outlet control servo motor.
(b) Measure the resistance of the servo motor.
Standard resistance
PT
GND
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A16-1 (VZ) - A16-2 (GND)
4.2 to 7.2 kΩ
VZ
E068754E03
(c) Measure the resistance of the servo motor.
Standard resistance
DEF
FACE
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
A16-3 (PT) - A16-2
(GND)
DEF position
0.6 to1.1 kΩ
A16-3 (PT) - A16-2
(GND)
FACE position
3.6 to 6.7 kΩ
HINT:
• Refer to the operation procedure for air outlet control
servo motor (see page AC-91).
• As the air outlet control servo motor moved from DEF
position to FACE position, the resistance decreases
gradually without interruption.
Resistance (kΩ)
3.6 to 6.7
Arm position
NG
REPLACE AIR OUTLET CONTROL SERVO
MOTOR
0.6 to 1.1
FACE
DEF
E127532E01
OK
AC
AC–80
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (AIR OUTLET CONTROL SERVO MOTOR - AIR CONDITIONING
AMPLIFIER)
Wire Harness Side
Air Outlet Control Servo Motor
VZ
A16
GND
PT
Air Conditioning Amplifier
A7
(a) Disconnect the A16 servo connector.
(b) Disconnect the A7 amplifier connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A7-18 (TPM) - A16-3 (PT)
Below 1 Ω
A7-23 (SGTPM) - A16-2 (GND)
Below 1 Ω
A7-11 (S5TPM) - A16-1 (VZ)
Below 1 Ω
A7-18 (TPM) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A7-23 (SGTPM) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A7-11 (S5TPM) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
SGTPM
S5TPM
TPM
E125233E02
OK
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
AC
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DTC
B1441
AC–81
Air Mix Damper Control Servo Motor Circuit
(Passenger Side)
DESCRIPTION
The air mix control servo motor (air mix damper servo) is controlled by the air conditioning amplifier.
The air mix control servo motor moves the air mix damper by rotating (normal, reverse) the motor with
electrical power from the air conditioning amplifier.
This adjusts the mix ratio of the air that passes through the evaporator and heater core and controls the
airflow temperature. Air flow temperature changes when moving the air mix damper to the target point.
The target point can be detected with the air mix damper position sensor.
DTC No.
Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1441
Air mix damper position sensor value does
not change even if air conditioning amplifier
assembly operates air mix servo motor.
•
•
•
Air mix control servo motor
Wire harness between air mix control
servo motor and air conditioning amplifier
Air conditioning amplifier
WIRING DIAGRAM
Air Conditioning Amplifier
Air Mix Control Servo Motor
PT
TP
GND
SGTP
VZ
S5TP
MCOOL
MHOT
AMC
AMH
E125211E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (A/M DAMP POS-P, TARG-P)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to DLC3.
AC
AC–82
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and push the intelligent
tester main switch ON.
(c) Select the item below in the DATA LIST, and read the
display on the intelligent tester.
Air conditioning amplifier
Item
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
A/M DAMP POS-P
Air mix damper position
(Passenger side) / min.: -14%
max.: 113.5%
Damper is at "MAX. COOL": 10.0%
-
A/M DAMP TARG-P
Air mix damper target position
(Passenger side) /
min.: -14% max.: 113.5%
Damper is at "MAX. COOL": 10.0%
-
OK:
When the target position is at the "MAX. COOL" (10.0%), the actual opening angle is 19.0% or less.
Result
Result
Proceed to
NG
A
OK (Checking from the PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE)
B
OK (Checking from the DTC)
C
B
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
C
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
A
2
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (A/M DAMP POS-P, TARG-P)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and push the intelligent
tester main switch ON.
(c) Select the item below in the DATA LIST, and read the
display on the intelligent tester.
Air conditioning amplifier
Item
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
A/M DAMP POS-P
Air mix damper position
(Passenger side) / min.: -14%
max.: 113.5%
Damper is at "MAX. HOT":
100.0% or 71.0%
-
A/M DAMP TARG-P
Air mix damper target position
(Passenger side) /
min.: -14% max.: 113.5%
Damper is at "MAX. HOT":
100.0% or 71.0%
-
OK:
When the target position is at the "MAX. HOT" (100.0%),
the actual opening angle is 81.0% or more.
Result
AC
Result
Proceed to
NG
A
OK (Checking from the PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE)
B
OK (Checking from the DTC)
C
AC–83
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
B
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
C
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
A
3
INSPECT AIR MIX CONTROL SERVO MOTOR
(a) Remove the air mix control servo motor.
(b) Connect the battery's positive (+) lead to terminal 5 and
negative (-) lead to terminal 4, then check that lever turns
to "MAX. HOT" position smoothly.
(c) Measure the resistance of the servo motor.
Standard resistance
MHOT
MCOOL
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
A15-3 (PT) - A15-2
(GND)
MAX. HOT position
0.8 to 1.6 kΩ
(d) Connect the battery's positive (+) lead to terminal 4 and
negative (-) lead to terminal 5, then check that lever turns
to "MAX. COOL" position smoothly.
(e) Measure the resistance of the servo motor.
Standard resistance
MAX. HOT
MAX. COOL
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
A15-3 (PT) - A15-2
(GND)
MAX. COOL position
3.6 to 6.7 kΩ
NG
E127533E01
REPLACE AIR MIX CONTROL SERVO
MOTOR
OK
AC
AC–84
4
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (AIR MIX CONTROL SERVO MOTOR - AIR CONDITIONING
AMPLIFIER)
Wire Harness Side
Air Mix Control Servo Motor
MHOT
A15
MCOOL
Air Conditioning Amplifier
(a) Disconnect the A15 servo connector.
(b) Disconnect the A8 amplifier connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A8-19 (AMC) - A15-4 (MCOOL)
Below 1 Ω
A8-17 (AMH) - A15-5 (MHOT)
Below 1 Ω
A8-19 (AMC) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A8-17 (AMH) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
A8
AMH
AMC
E125234E01
OK
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
AC
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DTC
B1442
AC–85
Air Inlet Damper Control Servo Motor Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The air inlet control servo motor is controlled by the air conditioning amplifier and moves the air inlet
control servo motor to the desired position.
The air inlet control servo motor switches between "RECIRCULATION" and "FRESH" by rotating the
motor (normal, reverse) with electrical power from the air conditioning amplifier. This controls intake air
and switches "RECIRCULATION", "FRESH" and "HALF-RECIRCULATION".
DTC No.
Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1442
Air outlet damper position sensor valve does
not change even if air conditioning amplifier
operated air outlet damper control servo
motor.
•
•
•
Air inlet control servo motor
Wire harness between air inlet control
servo motor and air conditioning amplifier
Air conditioning amplifier
WIRING DIAGRAM
Air Conditioning Amplifier
Air Inlet Control Servo Motor
PT
TPI
GND
SGTPI
VZ
S5TPI
Mrec
Mfrs
AIR
AIF
E125211E02
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (A/I DAMP POS, TARG)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON and push the intelligent tester
main switch ON.
AC
AC–86
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
(c) Select the item below in the DATA LIST, and read the
display on the intelligent tester.
Air conditioning amplifier
Item
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
A/I DAMP POS
Air inlet damper position /
min.: -14% max.: 113.5%
Damper is at
"RECIRCULATION": -1.0%
Damper is at "HALFRECIRCULATION": 20.0 to
102.0%
Open in the circuit: 50.0%
A/I DAMP TARG
Air inlet damper target position /
min.: -14% max.: 113.5%
Damper is at
"RECIRCULATION": -1.0%
Damper is at "HALFRECIRCULATION": 20.0 to
102.0%
Open in the circuit: 50.0%
OK:
When the target position is at the
"RECIRCULATION" (-1.0%), the actual opening
angle is 19.0% or less.
Result
Result
Proceed to
NG
A
OK (Checking from the PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE)
B
OK (Checking from the DTC)
C
B
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
C
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
A
2
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (A/I DAMP POS, TARG)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and push the intelligent
tester main switch ON.
(c) Select the item below in the DATA LIST, and read the
display on the intelligent tester.
Air conditioning amplifier
AC
Item
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
A/I DAMP POS
Air inlet damper position /
min.: -14% max.: 113.5%
Damper is at "FRESH": 110.0%
Damper is at "HALFRECIRCULATION": 20.0 to
102.0%
Open in the circuit: 50.0%
A/I DAMP TARG
Air inlet damper target position /
min.: -14% max.: 113.5%
Damper is at "FRESH": 110.0%
Damper is at "HALFRECIRCULATION": 20.0 to
102.0%
Open in the circuit: 50.0%
OK:
When the target position is at the "FRESH"
(110.0%), the actual opening angle is 81.0% or
more.
AC–87
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Result
Result
Proceed to
NG
A
OK (Checking from the PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE)
B
OK (Checking from the DTC)
C
B
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
C
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
A
3
INSPECT AIR INLET CONTROL SERVO MOTOR
(a) Remove the damper air inlet servo motor.
(b) Connect the battery's positive (+) lead to terminal 5 and
negative (-) lead to terminal 4 then check that the lever
turns to "FRESH" position smoothly.
(c) Measure the resistance of the servo motor.
Standard resistance
Mfrs
Mrec
RECIRCULATION
FRESH
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
A14-3 (PT) - A14-2
(GND)
FRESH position
0.6 to 1.1 kΩ
(d) Connect the battery's positive (+) lead to terminal 4 and
negative (-) lead to terminal 5 then check that the lever
turns to "RECIRCULATION" position smoothly.
(e) Measure the resistance of the servo motor.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
A14-3 (PT) - A14-2
(GND)
RECIRCULATION
position
3.4 to 6.2 kΩ
NG
E127534E01
REPLACE AIR INLET CONTROL SERVO
MOTOR
OK
AC
AC–88
4
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (AIR INLET CONTROL SERVO MOTOR - AIR CONDITIONING
AMPLIFIER)
Wire Harness Side
Air Inlet Control Servo Motor
Mfrs
A14
Mrec
Air Conditioning Amplifier
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A8-22 (AIR) - A14-4 (Mrec)
Below 1 Ω
A8-23 (AIF) - A14-5 (Mfrs)
Below 1 Ω
A8-22 (AIR) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A8-23 (AIF) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
A8
AIF
(a) Disconnect the A14 servo connector.
(b) Disconnect the A8 amplifier connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
AIR
E125234E02
OK
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
AC
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DTC
B1443
AC–89
Air Outlet Damper Control Servo Motor Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This circuit turns the servo motor and changes each damper position by receiving the signals from the air
conditioning amplifier.
The air outlet damper servo switches the air outlet by rotating the motor (normal, reverse) with electrical
power from the air conditioning amplifier.
When the AUTO switch is on, the air conditioning amplifier changes the mode between "FACE", "BILEVEL" and "FOOT" according to the temperature setting.
DTC No.
Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1443
Air outlet damper position sensor valve does
not change even if air conditioning amplifier
operated air outlet damper control servo
motor.
•
•
•
Air outlet control servo motor
Wire harness between air outlet control
servo motor and air conditioning amplifier
Air conditioning amplifier
WIRING DIAGRAM
Air Conditioning Amplifier
Air Outlet Control Servo Motor
PT
TPM
GND
SGTPM
VZ
S5TPM
MFACE
MDEF
AOF
AOD
E125211E03
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (A/O DAMP POS, TARG)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and push the intelligent
tester main switch ON.
AC
AC–90
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
(c) Select the item below in the DATA LIST, and read the
display on the intelligent tester.
Air conditioning amplifier
Item
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
A/O DAMP POS
Air outlet damper position /
min.: -14% max.: 113.5%
Damper is at "FACE": -10.0%
Damper is at "FACE/FOOT":
12.0%
Damper is at "FOOT" (Manual):
33.5% or 69.0%
Damper is at "FOOT" (Auto):
49.0% or 69.0%
Damper is at "FACE/DEF": 69.0%
or 95.0%
Open in the circuit: 50.0%
A/O DAMP TARG
Air outlet damper target position /
min.: -14% max.: 113.5%
Damper is at "FACE": -10.0%
Damper is at "FACE/FOOT":
12.0%
Damper is at "FOOT" (Manual):
33.5% or 69.0%
Damper is at "FOOT" (Auto):
49.0% or 69.0%
Damper is at "FACE/DEF": 69.0%
or 95.0%
Open in the circuit: 50.0%
OK:
When the target position is at the "FACE" (-10.0%),
the actual opening angle is 19.0% or less.
Result
Result
Proceed to
NG
A
OK (Checking from the PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE)
B
OK (Checking from the DTC)
C
B
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
C
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
A
2
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (A/O DAMP POS, TARG)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and push the intelligent
tester main switch ON.
(c) Select the item below in the DATA LIST, and read the
display on the intelligent tester.
Air conditioning amplifier
AC
Item
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
A/O DAMP POS
Air outlet damper position /
min.: -14% max.: 113.5%
Damper is at "FACE/FOOT":
12.0%
Damper is at "FOOT" (Manual):
33.5% or 69.0%
Damper is at "FOOT" (Auto):
49.0% or 69.0%
Damper is at "FACE/DEF": 69.0%
or 95.0%
Damper is at "DEF": 110.0%
Open in the circuit: 50.0%
AC–91
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Item
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
A/O DAMP TARG
Air outlet damper target position /
min.: -14% max.: 113.5%
Damper is at "FACE/FOOT":
12.0%
Damper is at "FOOT" (Manual):
33.5% or 69.0%
Damper is at "FOOT" (Auto):
49.0% or 69.0%
Damper is at "FACE/DEF": 69.0%
or 95.0%
Damper is at "DEF": 110.0%
Open in the circuit: 50.0%
OK:
When the target position is at the "DEF" (110.0%),
the actual opening angle is 81.0% or more.
Result
Result
Proceed to
NG
A
OK (Checking from the PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE)
B
OK (Checking from the DTC)
C
B
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
C
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
A
3
INSPECT AIR OUTLET CONTROL SERVO MOTOR
(a) Remove the air outlet control servo motor.
(b) Connect the battery's positive (+) lead to terminal 4 and
negative (-) lead to terminal 5 then check that the lever
turns to "FACE" position smoothly.
(c) Measure the resistance of the servo motor.
Standard resistance
MDEF
MFACE
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
A8-3 (PT) - A8-2 (GND)
FACE position
3.6 to 6.7 kΩ
(d) Connect the battery's positive (+) lead to terminal 5 and
negative (-) lead to terminal 4 then check that the lever
turn to "DEF" position smoothly.
(e) Measure the resistance of the servo motor.
Standard resistance
DEF
FACE
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
A8-3 (PT) - A8-2 (GND)
DEF position
0.6 to 1.1 kΩ
NG
REPLACE AIR OUTLET CONTROL SERVO
MOTOR
E127535E01
OK
AC
AC–92
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (AIR OUTLET CONTROL SERVO MOTOR - AIR CONDITIONING
AMPLIFIER)
Wire Harness Side
Air Outlet Control Servo Motor
MDEF
A16
MFACE
Air Conditioning Amplifier
(a) Disconnect the A16 servo connector.
(b) Disconnect the A8 amplifier connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A8-16 (AOF) - A16-4 (MFACE)
Below 1 Ω
A8-24 (AOD) - A16-5 (MDEF)
Below 1 Ω
A8-16 (AOF) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A8-24 (AOD) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
A8
AOF
AOD
E125234E03
OK
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
AC
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
AC–93
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DTC
B1462
Room Humidity Sensor Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The room humidity sensor detects room humidity. The voltage of the room humidity sensor changes in
accordance with room humidity. The air conditioning amplifier reads changes in the room humidity sensor.
The room humidity sensor is integrated with room temperature sensor.
DTC No.
Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1462
Open or short in room humidity sensor circuit
•
•
•
Room humidity sensor (room temperature
sensor)
Wire harness between room humidity
sensor ( room temperature sensor) and
air conditioning amplifier
Air conditioning amplifier
WIRING DIAGRAM
Room Temperature Sensor
Air Conditioning Amplifier
THR
Room Humidity
Sensor Area
TR
GND
SGTR
VO
Room Temperature
Sensor Area
RH
S5
S5RM
E125205E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (HUMIDITY SENS)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and push the intelligent
tester main switch ON.
(c) Select the item below in the DATA LIST, and read the
display on the intelligent tester.
Air conditioning amplifier
Item
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
HUMIDITY SENS
Humidity sensor /
min.: 0% max.: 100%
Actual room humidity is displayed
-
AC
AC–94
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
OK:
The displayed is as specified in the normal
condition.
Result
Result
Proceed to
NG
A
OK (Checking from the PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE)
B
OK (Checking from the DTC)
C
B
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
C
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
A
2
CHECK AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER (RH VOLTAGE)
RH
A7
S5RM
(a) Remove the air conditioning amplifier with connectors
still connected.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
A7-9 (RH) - A7-10
(S5RM)
Power switch ON (IG) at
25°C (77°F)
1.8 to 2.2 V
A7-9 (RH) - A7-10
(S5RM)
Power switch ON (IG) at
40°C (104°F)
1.2 to 1.6 V
I041186E09
A
AC
HINT:
As the temperature increases, the voltage decreases.
Result
Result
Proceed to
NG
A
OK (Checking from the PROBLEM
SYMPTOMS TABLE)
B
OK (Checking from the DTC)
C
B
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
C
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
3
AC–95
INSPECT ROOM TEMPERATURE SENSOR (HUMIDITY SENSOR)
S5
(a) Remove the room temperature sensor.
(b) Measure the voltage of the sensor.
Standard voltage:
at 25°C (77°F) Humidity 40%: 1.61 to 2.24 V
at 25°C (77°F) Humidity 60%: 2.26 to 2.66 V
HINT:
As the humidity increases, the voltage increases (see
the graph).
VO
NG
Voltage (V)
REPLACE ROOM TEMPERATURE SENSOR
㪊㪅㪌
㪊㪅㪇
㪉㪅㪌
㪉㪅㪇
㪈㪅㪌
㪈㪅㪇
㪇㪅㪌
㪇
㪈㪇 㪉㪇 㪊㪇 㪋㪇 㪌㪇 㪍㪇 㪎㪇 㪏㪇 㪐㪇 㪈㪇㪇
Humidity (%)
E127526E01
OK
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ROOM HUMIDITY SENSOR - AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER)
(a) Disconnect the A9 sensor connector.
(b) Disconnect the A7 amplifier connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Room Humidity Sensor
S5
A9
VO
Air Conditioning Amplifier
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A7-9 (RH) - A9-3 (VO)
Below 1 Ω
A7-10 (S5RM) - A9-4 (S5)
Below 1 Ω
A7-9 (RH) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A7-10 (S5RM) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
A7
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
RH
S5RM
E125235E01
AC
AC–96
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
OK
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
AC
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DTC
B1471
AC–97
A/C Inverter High Voltage Power Resource System Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The A/C inverter monitors the power voltage from the main battery in the self circuit. It stops compressor
control and outputs the DTC when the monitored voltage is outside the specified range.
The output DTC is memorized as previous trouble. Compressor control may not resume unless the power
switch is turned OFF.
HINT:
The hybrid control system and air conditioning system output DTCs separately. Inspect DTCs following
the flowchart for the hybrid control system first if any DTCs from those systems are output simultaneously.
DTC No.
Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1471
Open or short in A/C inverter high voltage
power resource system
•
•
Hybrid control ECU
A/C inverter (inverter with converter)
NOTICE:
The A/C inverter is integrated with the inverter with converter. It is necessary to replace the PCU
box if the A/C inverter (inverter with converter) needs to be replaced because the A/C inverter
(inverter with converter) cannot be replaced alone.
AC
AC–98
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Air Conditioning Amplifier
See Multiplex Communication System
(BEAN Bus)
MPX+
MPX2+
Hybrid Control ECM
See Multiplex Communication System
(CAN Bus)
CANH
CANL
Inverter with Converter
IG1
A/C (HTR)
IG
TOINV
ETI
TOECU
ITE
Power Source Control ECU
DC/DC
AM1
IGID
CLK
AM2
CLK
GND
P/I
MAIN
E125212E01
AC
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
AC–99
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE
(a) Check if DTCs for the hybrid control system are output
using intelligent tester.
OK:
DTCs are not output in the hybrid control system.
NG
GO TO HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
OK
REPLACE A/C INVERTER
AC
AC–100
DTC
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
B1472
A/C Inverter High Voltage Output System Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The high voltage is output from the A/C inverter to the electric inverter compressor for driving the motor.
Compressor control is stopped and the DTC is output if there is an open or short to ground in the output
circuit.
The output DTC is memorized as previous trouble. Compressor control remains stopped unless the past
and current DTCs are cleared by intelligent tester.
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves and pull out the service plug grip before inspection as procedures may
require disconnecting high-voltage connectors.
HINT:
The hybrid vehicle system and air conditioning system output DTCs separately. Inspect DTCs following
the flowchart for the hybrid system first if any DTCs from those systems are output simultaneously.
DTC No.
Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1472
Open or short in A/C inverter high voltage
output system
•
•
•
Hybrid control ECU
Electric inverter compressor (w/ motor
compressor)
A/C inverter (inverter with converter)
NOTICE:
The A/C inverter is integrated with the inverter with converter. It is necessary to replace the PCU
box if the A/C inverter (inverter with converter) needs to be replaced because the A/C inverter
(inverter with converter) cannot be replaced alone.
AC
AC–101
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Air Conditioning Amplifier
See Multiplex Communication System
(BEAN Bus)
MPX+
MPX2+
Hybrid Control ECM
See Multiplex Communication System
(CAN Bus)
CANH
CANL
Electric Inverter Compressor
Inverter with Converter
OUT-W
TOINV
ETI
OUT-V
TOECU
ITE
OUT-U
CLK
CLK
E125213E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK ELECTRIC INVERTER COMPRESSOR
C4
OUT-U OUT-W
OUT-V
Electric Inverter Compressor
E072789E02
(a) Remove the service plug grip.
CAUTION:
Because the compressor has a high-voltage circuit,
wear insulated gloves and pull out the service plug
to cut the high-voltage circuit before inspection.
(b) Disconnect the C4 electric inverter compressor
connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the inverter compressor
immediately after the compressor is stopped.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
C4-1 (OUT-W) - C4-2 (OUT-V)
0.5 to 0.8 Ω
C4-1 (OUT-W) - C4-3 (OUT-U)
0.5 to 0.8 Ω
C4-2 (OUT-V) - C4-3 (OUT-U)
0.5 to 0.8 Ω
AC
AC–102
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
NG
OK
REPLACE A/C INVERTER
AC
REPLACE ELECTRIC INVERTER
COMPRESSOR
AC–103
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DTC
B1473
A/C Inverter Start-up Signal System Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The inverter activation signal is sent to the A/C inverter from the hybrid control ECU. Compressor control
is stopped and the DTC is output if there is an open or short in the signal circuit.
DTC No.
Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1473
Open or short in A/C inverter start-up signal
system
•
•
•
Wire harness between hybrid control ECU
and A/C inverter (inverter with converter)
A/C inverter (inverter with converter)
Hybrid control ECU
NOTICE:
The A/C inverter is integrated with the inverter with converter. It is necessary to replace the PCU
box if the A/C inverter (inverter with converter) needs to be replaced because the A/C inverter
(inverter with converter) cannot be replaced alone.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Air Conditioning Amplifier
See Multiplex Communication System
(BEAN Bus)
MPX+
MPX2+
Hybrid Control ECU
See Multiplex Communication System
(CAN Bus)
CANH
CANL
Inverter
STB
STB
E125214E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE
(a) Check if DTCs for the hybrid control system are output
using intelligent tester.
AC
AC–104
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
OK:
DTCs are not output in the hybrid control system.
NG
GO TO HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (HYBRID CONTROL ECU - A/C INVERTER)
(a) Disconnect the H11 ECU connector.
(b) Disconnect the I11 inverter connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Hybrid Control ECU
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
H11-25 (STB) - I11-5 (STB)
0.5 to 0.8 Ω
H11-25 (STB) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
H11
NG
STB
A/C Inverter
I11
STB
E127536E01
OK
REPLACE A/C INVERTER
AC
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DTC
B1475
AC–105
A/C Inverter Cooling / Heating System Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The A/C inverter in the A/C inverter monitors the cooling water temperature with the temperature sensor.
It stops compressor control and outputs the DTC when the monitored temperature is outside specified
range (too high or too low).
The hybrid system and the air conditioning system monitor the cooling water temperature separately. If
DTCs referring to an inverter cooling system malfunction are output simultaneously, there may be trouble
such as insufficient cooling water.
If DTCs are output only for the air conditioning system, there may be an open or short in the temperature
sensor circuit in the inverter.
DTC No.
Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1475
Cooling water temperature in the inverter is
outside the specified range (temperature is
too high), or there is an open or short to
ground in the temperature sensor circuit.
A/C inverter (inverter with converter)
NOTICE:
The A/C inverter is integrated with the inverter with converter. It is necessary to replace the PCU
box if the A/C inverter (inverter with converter) needs to be replaced because the A/C inverter
(inverter with converter) cannot be replaced alone.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK COOLING WATER
NOTICE:
Even if DTCs are output only for the air conditioning
system, inspect the cooling system first and check that it
is normal as there may be trouble such as insufficient
cooling water.
NG
ADD COOLING WATER
OK
2
CHECK DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE
(a) Check if DTCs for the hybrid control system are output
using intelligent tester.
OK:
DTCs are not output in the hybrid control system.
NG
GO TO HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
OK
REPLACE A/C INVERTER
AC
AC–106
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DTC
B1476
A/C Inverter Load System Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The A/C inverter stops compressor control and outputs the DTC if the rotation load is too great or too
small while controlling motor rotation in the A/C inverter.
HINT:
Possible reasons could be as follows: Load is low when the refrigerant gas leaks, or load is too great
when refrigerant gas is excessively charged, insufficient cooling performance due to condenser fan circuit
trouble, or the compressor locked up.
DTC No.
Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1476
Motor's rotation load while the compressor is
operating is too great or too small.
•
•
•
Volume of refrigerant
Electric inverter compressor (w/ motor
compressor)
Cooling fan circuit
NOTICE:
The A/C inverter is integrated with the inverter with converter. It is necessary to replace the PCU
box if the A/C inverter (inverter with converter) needs to be replaced because the A/C inverter
(inverter with converter) cannot be replaced alone.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK COOLER CONDENSER ASSEMBLY
(a) Turn the power switch OFF and ON (READY).
(b) Set the A/C temperature setting to "MAX. COOL" and
the blower to " LO", and turn the A/C switch ON.
(c) Check operation of the condenser fan.
OK:
The condenser fan rotates.
NG
OK
AC
INSPECT COOLING FAN SYSTEM
AC–107
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
2
CHECK HFC-134A (R134A)
(a) Inspect refrigerant volume.
(1) Check the sight glass of the cooler unit refrigerant
liquid pipe E.
(2) Set the vehicle according to the conditions below.
Sight Glass
Item
Condition
All Doors
Fully open
Temperature Setting
Max. COOL
Blower Speed
HI
A/C
ON
(3) Check the sight glass.
I038559E03
Item
Symptom
Amount of refrigerant
Corrective Actions
1
Bubbles exist
Insufficient*
(1) Check for gas leakage and
repair if necessary
(2) Add refrigerant until bubbles
disappear
2
No bubbles exist (DTC B1476 is
output)
Empty, insufficient or excessive
Refer to 3 and 4
3
No temperature difference
between compressor inlet and
outlet
Empty or nearly empty
(1) Check for gas leakage with
gas leak detector and repair if
necessary
(2) Add refrigerant until bubbles
disappear
4
Considerable temperature
difference between compressor
inlet and outlet
Proper or excessive
Refer to 5 and 6
5
Immediately after air conditioning
is turned off, refrigerant remains
clear
Excessive
(1) Discharge refrigerant
(2) Remove air and supply proper
amount of purified refrigerant
6
Immediately after air conditioning
is turned off, refrigerant foams
and then becomes clear
Proper
-
HINT:
*: Bubbles in the sight glass with room temperature
higher than usual can be considered normal if
cooling is sufficient.
NG
CHARGE REFRIGERANT
OK
REPLACE ELECTRIC INVERTER COMPRESSOR
AC
AC–108
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DTC
B1477
A/C Inverter Low Voltage Power Resource System Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The A/C inverter monitors the controlling power voltage in the self circuit. It stops compressor circuit and
outputs the DTC when the monitored voltage is outside the specified range.
The output DTC is memorized as previous trouble. The compressor control may not resume unless the
power switch is turned OFF.
DTC No.
Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1477
An open or short to ground in the inverter's
controlling power voltage circuit.
A/C inverter (inverter with converter)
NOTICE:
The A/C inverter is integrated with the inverter with converter. It is necessary to replace the PCU
box if the A/C inverter (inverter with converter) needs to be replaced because the A/C inverter
(inverter with converter) cannot be replaced alone.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE
(a) Check if DTCs for the hybrid control system are output
using intelligent tester.
OK:
DTCs are not output in the hybrid control system.
NG
OK
REPLACE A/C INVERTER
AC
GO TO HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
AC–109
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DTC
B1498
Communication Malfunction (A/C Inverter
Local)
DESCRIPTION
The hybrid control ECU and A/C inverter transmit information to one another via communication line.
Compressor control is stopped and the DTC is output if communication information is cut off or abnormal
information occurs.
The output DTC is memorized as previous trouble.
DTC No.
Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1498
Communication line error or open between
the hybrid control ECU and the A/C inverter
(inverter with converter)
•
•
•
Wire harness between hybrid control ECU
and A/C inverter (inverter with converter)
Hybrid control ECU
A/C inverter (inverter with converter)
NOTICE:
The A/C inverter is integrated with the inverter with converter. It is necessary to replace the PCU
box if the A/C inverter (inverter with converter) needs to be replaced because the A/C inverter
(inverter with converter) cannot be replaced alone.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Air Conditioning Amplifier
See Multiplex Communication System
(BEAN Bus)
MPX+
MPX2+
Hybrid Control ECU
See Multiplex Communication System
(CAN Bus)
CANH
CANL
Inverter with Converter
TOINV
ETI
TOECU
ITE
CLK
CLK
AC
E125215E01
AC–110
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (HYBRID CONTROL ECU - INVERTER WITH CONVERTER)
(a) Disconnect the H15 and H16 ECU connectors.
(b) Disconnect the I11 inverter connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Hybrid Control ECU
Tester Connection
H16
CLK
H15
ITE
Specified Condition
H15-24 (ETI) - I11-3 (TOINV)
Below 1 Ω
H16-14 (ITE) - I11-2 (TOECU)
Below 1 Ω
H16-17 (CLK) - I11-4 (CLK)
Below 1 Ω
H15-24 (ETI) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
H16-14 (ITE) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
H16-17 (CLK) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
ETI
NG
Inverter with Converter
I11
CLK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
TOECU
TOINV
E127537E01
OK
2
CHECK DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE
(a) Connect the H15 and H16 ECU connectors.
(b) Connect the I11 inverter connector.
(c) Check if DTCs for the hybrid control system are output
using intelligent tester.
OK:
DTCs are not output in the hybrid control system.
NG
OK
REPLACE A/C INVERTER
AC
GO TO HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
DTC
P0AA6611
AC–111
Hybrid Battery Voltage System Isolation Fault
DESCRIPTION
The DTC is output if there is insulation trouble with the high-voltage circuits in the air conditioning system.
Insulation trouble with the electric inverter compressor or A/C inverter may be the cause. Any oil other
than ND-OIL 11 may have entered the refrigeration cycle.
The motor driven with high-voltage is built into the electrical compressor and is cooled directly with
refrigerant. Compressor oil (ND-OIL 11) with high insulation performance is used because a leakage of
electrical power may occur if regular compressor oil (ND-OIL 8) is used.
NOTICE:
• Electrical insulation performance may decrease significantly if even a small amount of oil other
than ND-OIL 11 is used or enters the refrigeration cycle, causing the DTC to be output.
• If other oil is accidentally used and a DTC is output, collect the oil in the refrigeration cycle into
the compressor and replace it with ND-OIL 11 to increase the ND-OIL 11 ratio amount.
• Replace the main components (evaporator, condenser, and compressor) if a large amount of oil
other than ND-OIL 11 enters the system. Failing to do so may cause electrical insulation
performance to remain low, causing the DTC to be output.
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves and pull out the service plug grip before inspection as procedures may
require disconnecting high-voltage connectors.
DTC No.
Detection item
Trouble Area
P0AA6-611
High voltage system insulation malfunction.
•
•
•
Electric inverter compressor (w/ motor
compressor)
A/C inverter (inverter with converter)
Compressor oil
NOTICE:
The A/C inverter is integrated with the inverter with converter. It is necessary to replace the PCU
box if the A/C inverter (inverter with converter) needs to be replaced because the A/C inverter
(inverter with converter) cannot be replaced alone.
1
CHECK A/C INVERTER
Wire Harness Side
C4
OUT-V
OUT-W
Electric Inverter Compressor
OUT-U
I041196E03
(a) Remove the service plug grip.
CAUTION:
Because the compressor has a high-voltage circuit,
wear insulated gloves and pull out the service plug
to cut the high-voltage circuit before inspection.
(b) Disconnect the C4 inverter connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector immediately after the compressor is stopped.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
C4-1 (OUT-W) - Body ground
2 MΩ or higher
C4-2 (OUT-V) - Body ground
2 MΩ or higher
C4-3 (OUT-U) - Body ground
2 MΩ or higher
NG
OK
REPLACE A/C INVERTER
AC
AC–112
2
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
CHECK ELECTRIC INVERTER COMPRESSOR
(a) Remove the service plug grip.
CAUTION:
Because the compressor has a high-voltage circuit,
wear insulated gloves and pull out the service plug
to cut the high-voltage circuit before inspection.
(b) Disconnect the C4 compressor connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
C4
Electric Inverter Compressor
E072789E04
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
C4-1 - Body ground
2 MΩ or higher
C4-2 - Body ground
2 MΩ or higher
C4-3 - Body ground
2 MΩ or higher
NG
REPLACE ELECTRIC INVERTER
COMPRESSOR
OK
3
AC
CHECK ELECTRIC INVERTER COMPRESSOR
(a) Connect the electric inverter compressor connector.
(b) Install the service plug grip.
CAUTION:
Because the compressor has a high-voltage circuit,
wear insulated gloves and pull out the service plug
to cut the high-voltage circuit before inspection.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Set the A/C setting temperature to 25°C (77°F) and the
blower switch LO. Then operate the compressor for 10
minutes to circulate the refrigerant cycle with refrigerant
and collect as much compressor oil remaining in each
component into the compressor as possible.
HINT:
Inspect with sufficient oil in the compressor since the
insulation resistance of the compressor changes
depending on the amount of oil in the compressor.
(e) Turn the power switch OFF, and leave the vehicle for a
night to cool down the compressor's internal
temperature.
NOTICE:
Do not operate the compressor before inspection.
HINT:
• Leave the vehicle until the compressor temperature
decreases below ambient temperature. (As the
compressor temperature decreases below the
temperature of the condenser and evaporator, more
oil can be stored in the compressor.)
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
• If there is significant difference in temperature
between day and night time, it will take approximately
4 hours to cool down the compressor. Remove the
service plug grip.
(f) Remove the service plug grip.
CAUTION:
Because the compressor has a high-voltage circuit,
wear insulated gloves and pull out the service plug
to cut the high-voltage circuit before inspection.
(g) Disconnect the C4 compressor connector.
(h) Measure the resistance of the connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
C4
Electric Inverter Compressor
AC–113
E072789E04
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
C4-1 - Body ground
3 MΩ or higher
C4-2 - Body ground
3 MΩ or higher
C4-3 - Body ground
3 MΩ or higher
NOTICE:
If the results are out of the specified range, replace
the compressor without operating.
NG
REPLACE ELECTRIC INVERTER
COMPRESSOR
OK
SYSTEM IS OK
AC
AC–114
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Blower Motor Circuit
DESCRIPTION
Blower Level
HI
M3
M2
M1
LO
29 41 53 67 89
SI duty (%)
A
100 (%)
Duty Ratio =
A+B
0
ON
OFF
A
B
1 cycle
E110709E03
The blower motor is operated by signals from the air conditioning amplifier. Blower motor speed signals
are transmitted by changes in the duty ratio.
Duty Ratio
The duty ratio is the ratio of the period of continuity in one cycle. For example, A is the period of continuity
in one cycle, and B is the period of non-continuity.
The blower motor controller controls the blower motor speed.
The blower motor controller reads the signal from the air conditioning amplifier and controls rotation and
speed.
AC
AC–115
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Blower Motor Controller
Air Conditioning Amplifier
SI
BLW
from HTR Relay
+B
MBlower Motor
M+
GND
E125222E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (BLOWER MOTOR)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and push the intelligent
tester main switch ON.
(c) Select the item below in the ACTIVE TEST and then
check that the relay operates.
Air conditioning amplifier
Item
Test Details / Display (Range)
Diagnostic Note
BLOWER MOTOR
Blower motor / min.: 0 max.: 31
-
Result
Result
Proceed to
NG (Blower motor does not operate)
A
NG (Blower motor operate but does not change speed)
B
OK
C
B
C
Go to step 6
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AC
AC–116
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
A
2
INSPECT BLOWER W/ FAN MOTOR SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the cooling unit motor w/ fan.
(b) Connect the battery's positive (+) lead to terminal 1 of
blower motor and negative (-) lead to terminal 2.
OK:
Blower motor operates smoothly.
Wire Harness Side
B2
Blower w/ Fan Motor
NG
REPLACE BLOWER W/ FAN MOTOR SUBASSEMBLY
E072794E01
OK
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (BLOWER MOTOR CONTROLLER - BATTERY)
(a) Disconnect the B3 controller connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
B3
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
B3-1 (+B) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
NG
+B
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
E072793E01
OK
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (BLOWER MOTOR CONTROLLER - BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the B3 controller connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
B3
GND
E072793E03
OK
AC
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
B3-3 (GND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
5
AC–117
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (BLOWER MOTOR - BLOWER MOTOR CONTROLLER)
Wire Harness Side
(a) Disconnect the B2 motor connector.
(b) Disconnect the B4 controller connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Blower Motor
B2
Blower Motor Controller
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
B4-1 (M-) - B2-2
Below 1 Ω
B4-2 (M+) - B2-1
Below 1 Ω
B4-1 (M-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
B4-2 (M+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
B4
NG
M+
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
M-
E125236E01
OK
6
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (BLOWER MOTOR CONTROLLER - AIR CONDITIONING
AMPLIFIER)
(a) Disconnect the B3 controller connector.
(b) Disconnect the A8 amplifier connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Blower Motor Controller
B3
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A8-2 (BLW) - B3-2 (SI)
Below 1 Ω
A8-2 (BLW) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
SI
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
Air Conditioning Amplifier
A8
BLW
E127521E01
AC
AC–118
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
OK
7
CHECK BLOWER MOTOR CONTROLLER (BLW VOLTAGE)
(a) Disconnect the A8 amplifier connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
A8
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
B3-1 (+B) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
NG
BLW
REPLACE BLOWER MOTOR CONTROLLER
E127522E01
OK
8
CHECK AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER (BLW - BODY GROUND)
(a) Remove the air conditioning amplifier with its connectors
still connected.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Turn the blower switch ON (Lo).
Wire Harness Side
A8
BLW
E127522E01
(d) Using an oscilloscope, measure the waveform of the
amplifier.
OK:
Waveform is as shown in the illustration.
Waveform 1
2 V/DIV.
Item
Content
Tester Connection
A8-2 (BLW) - Body ground
Tool Setting
2 V/DIV., 500 msec./DIV.
Condition
Blower switch ON (Lo)
HINT:
Waveform varies depending on the blower switch
setting.
GND
NG
500 msec./DIV.
I031456E19
OK
AC
REPLACE BLOWER MOTOR CONTROLLER
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
AC–119
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Heater Relay Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The heater relay is turned on by signals from the air conditioning amplifier. It supplies power to the blower
motor controller.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Air Conditioning Amplifier
from IG1 Relay
HTR
GAUGE
HR
DC/DC
HTR
to Blower Motor
Controller
MAIN
E125218E02
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT FUSE (GAUGE, HTR)
(a) Remove the GAUGE fuse from the driver side junction
block.
(b) Remove the HTR H-fuse from the engine room junction
block.
(c) Measure the resistance of the fuses.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
AC
AC–120
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
NG
REPLACE FUSE
OK
2
INSPECT HEATER RELAY (Marking: HTR)
(a) Remove the heater relay from the driver side junction
block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the relay.
Standard resistance
1
4
3
5
2
1
3
5
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(When battery voltage applied to
terminals 1 and 2)
2
E127527E01
3-4
Below 1 Ω
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
(When battery voltage applied to
terminals 1 and 2)
NG
REPLACE HEATER RELAY
OK
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (BATTERY - AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER)
(a) Disconnect the A8 amplifier connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
A8
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
A8-7 (HR) - Body
ground
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
NG
HR
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
E127522E03
OK
4
CHECK AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER (HR VOLTAGE)
(a) Remove the air conditioning amplifier with connectors
still connected.
(b) Measure the voltage of the connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
A8
AC
HR
E127522E03
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
A8-7 (HR) - Body
ground
Power switch OFF
Blower switch position
ON
Below 1 V
A8-7 (HR) - Body
ground
Power switch ON (IG)
Blower switch position
ON
Below 1 V
AC–121
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
A8-7 (HR) - Body
ground
Power switch ON (IG)
Blower switch position
OFF
10 to 14 V
NG
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AC
AC–122
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Heater Water Pump Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The heater water pump sends engine coolant to the heater core while the engine is stopped to prevent
heater effectiveness from becoming low.
Directed by the air conditioning amplifier, hybrid control ECU operates the water pump relay and drives
the heater water pump.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Air Conditioning Amplifier
See Multiplex Communication System
(BEAN Bus)
MPX+
MPX2+
Hybrid Control ECU
See Multiplex Communication System
(CAN Bus)
CANH
CANL
AC W/P
WP
Water Pump Motor
from
A/C (HTR) Fuse
E125221E01
AC
AC–123
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY (UNIT C: AC W/P)
(a) Remove the integration relay from the engine room
junction block.
NOTICE:
As the integration relay is connected to the relays
and fuses in the other systems, remove it with the
power switch OFF. (A DTC may be output if the
power switch is ON (IG).
(b) Measure the resistance of the relay.
Standard resistance
5
3H
4
3H
3
3H
Terminal No.
Specified Condition
3H-4 - 3H-5
10 kΩ or higher
3H-4 - 3H-5
Below 1 Ω
(When battery voltage applied to
terminals 3H-5 and 3H-3)
3H
NG
REPLACE INTEGRATION RELAY
I041202E01
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (HYBRID CONTROL ECU - BATTERY)
(a) Install the integration relay.
(b) Disconnect the H16 ECU connectors.
Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
H16
WP
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
H16-5 (WP) - Body
ground
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
NG
E127523E01
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
AC
AC–124
3
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
CHECK HYBRID CONTROL ECU (WP VOLTAGE)
(a) Measure the voltage of the connector.
Standard voltage
Hybrid Control ECU
H16
WP
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
H16-5 (WP) - Body
ground
Heater water pump not
operated
10 to 14 V
H16-5 (WP) - Body
ground
Heater water pump
operated
Below 1 V
NG
REPLACE HYBRID CONTROL ECU
I036410E02
OK
4
INSPECT HEATER WATER PUMP ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the heater water pump.
(b) Connect positive (+) lead to terminal 1 of the heater
water pump connector and negative (-) lead to terminal
2.
OK:
Heater water pump operates smoothly.
NOTICE:
Complete operation within 10 seconds if there is no
water in the heater water pump.
NG
REPLACE HEATER WATER PUMP
ASSEMBLY
2 1
I036418E01
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
AC
AC–125
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
PTC Heater Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The PTC heater is installed in the radiator in the heater unit on the driver and passenger's FOOT sides
and operates when cooling water temperature is low and normal heater effectiveness is insufficient.
The air conditioning amplifier switches the circuit in the PTC relay and operates the PTC heater when the
operating conditions (cooling water temperature is below 55°C (131°F), setting temperature is MAX. HOT,
air outlet damper position is FOOT or FOOT / DEF and blower switch in not OFF) are met.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Air Conditioning Amplifier
PTC HTR 1
PTC
PTC HTR1
from IG1 Relay
PTC HTR 2
GAUGE
HT-1
PTC HTR2
PS HTR
HT-2
PS HTR
DC/DC
PTC Heater
PTC Heater
MAIN
AC
E125220E01
AC–126
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT FUSE (PS HTR, PTC HTR1, PTC HTR2, GAUGE)
(a) Remove the PS HTR H-fuse, PTC HTR1 and PTC HTR2
fuses from the engine room junction block.
(b) Remove the GAUGE fuse from the driver side junction
block.
(c) Measure the resistance of the fuses.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE FUSE
OK
2
INSPECT PTC HEATER RELAY (Marking: PS HTR, PTC HTR 1, PTC HTR 2)
(a) Remove the PS HTR, PTC HTR 1 and PTC HTR 2
heater relays from the engine room No. 2 relay block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the relays.
Standard resistance
PS HTR
2
3
2
5
3
5
1
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(When battery voltage applied to
terminals 1 and 2)
1
PTC HTR 1, PTC HTR 2
2
1
5
3
1
2
5
3
E127528E01
OK
AC
NG
REPLACE PTC HEATER RELAY
AC–127
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER - BATTERY)
(a) Disconnect the A7 air conditioning amplifier connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
A7
PTC
HT-2
HT-1
E127524E01
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
A7-17 (PTC) - Body
ground
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
A7-26 (HT-1) - Body
ground
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
A7-25 (HT-2) - Body
ground
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
4
CHECK AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER (PTC, HT-1, HT-2, VOLTAGE)
(a) Connect the connectors.
(b) Measure the voltage of the connector.
Standard voltage
A7
PTC HT-1
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
A7-17 (PTC) - Body
ground
Power switch ON
(READY)
Temperature: Max. HOT
Ventilator mode: FOOT
Coolant temperature:
55°C (131°F) or lower
Blower switch: OFF →
LO (after 30 sec.)
Below 1 V → 10 to 14 V
A7-26 (HT-1) - Body
ground
Power switch ON
(READY)
Temperature: Max. HOT
Ventilator mode: FOOT
Coolant temperature:
55°C (131°F) or lower
Blower switch: OFF →
LO (after 30 sec.)
Below 1 V → 10 to 14 V
A7-25 (HT-2) - Body
ground
Power switch ON
(READY)
Temperature: Max. HOT
Ventilator mode: FOOT
Coolant temperature:
55°C (131°F) or lower
Blower switch: OFF →
LO (after 30 sec.)
Below 1 V → 10 to 14 V
HT-2
I041186E13
HINT:
• PTC operation may stop when the electric load on the
vehicle is high. Perform the inspection under
conditions with low electric load (such as with
headlights turned OFF).
• Since the 2 PTC heaters are gradually turned to the
ON position, perform the inspection 30 seconds after
the blower switch is turned to the LO position.
AC
AC–128
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
NG
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
OK
5
INSPECT PTC HEATER
(a) Disconnect the connector from the PTC heater.
(b) Check the continuity between each terminal.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
P12-1 - P12-2
Continuity (0.5 kΩ or higher)
P12-3 - P12-4
Continuity (0.5 kΩ or higher)
NG
REPLACE PTC HEATER
E072666E01
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
AC
AC–129
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Steering Pad Switch Circuit
DESCRIPTION
AUTO, TEMP UP (+), TEMP DOWN (-), Recirculation / Fresh, Fr. DEF and Rr. DEF switches are located
on the steering pad switch.
The resistance of the steering pad switch changes in accordance with switch operation. The air
conditioning amplifier outputs voltage to the steering pad switch and reads voltage changes according to
the resistance changes with switch operation.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Air Conditioning Amplifier
Spiral Cable
ST1
SGST
ST2
Steering Pad Switch Cable
Steering Pad Switch LH
AC2
AC2
AUTO
EAC
Steering Pad Switch RH
TEMP+
AC2
TEMPEAC
EAC
Front
DEF
AC1
AC1
Rear
DEF
Inlet
Air
AC1
E125219E01
AC
AC–130
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER (ST1, ST2 VOLTAGE)
(a) Remove the air conditioning with connectors still
connected.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard voltage
A7
SGST
ST1
ST2
I041186E12
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
A7-2 (ST1) - A7-15
(SGST)
Power switch ON (IG)
Fr. DEF switch ON
Below 0.3 V
A7-2 (ST1) - A7-15
(SGST)
Power switch ON (IG)
Rr. DEF switch ON
0.8 to 1.5 V
A7-2 (ST1) - A7-15
(SGST)
Power switch ON (IG)
Recirculation/Fresh
switch ON
2.0 to 2.9 V
A7-1 (ST2) - A7-15
(SGST)
Power switch ON (IG)
AUTO switch ON
Below 0.3 V
A7-1 (ST2) - A7-15
(SGST)
Power switch ON (IG)
TEMP+ switch ON
0.8 to 1.5 V
A7-1 (ST2) - A7-15
(SGST)
Power switch ON (IG)
TEMP- switch ON
2.0 to 2.9 V
OK
NG
AC
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AC–131
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
2
INSPECT STEERING PAD SWITCH LH
Connector A
AC2
(a) Remove the steering pad switch LH.
(b) Measure the resistance of the connectors.
Standard resistance
AC1
EAC
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
A2 (AC2) - B5 (AC1)
Always
1,210 Ω
A7 (EAC) - B6 (EAC)
Always
Below 1 Ω
A3 (AC1) - B5 (AC1)
Always
Below 1 Ω
A2 (AC2) - A7 (EAC)
AUTO switch ON
Below 1 Ω
A2 (AC2) - A7 (EAC)
TEMP + switch ON
300 Ω
A2 (AC2) - A7 (EAC)
TEMP - switch ON
1,210 Ω
NG
REPLACE STEERING PAD SWITCH LH
Steering Pad Switch LH
Connector B
AC2
EAC
AC1
I041198E01
OK
AC
AC–132
3
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECT STEERING PAD SWITCH RH
(a) Remove the steering pad switch RH.
(b) Measure the resistance of the connector.
Standard resistance
Steering Pad Switch RH
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
2 (AC1) -1 (EAC)
Fr. DEF switch ON
Below 1 Ω
2 (AC1) -1 (EAC)
Rr. DEF switch ON
300 Ω
2 (AC1) -1 (EAC)
Recirculation/Fresh
switch ON
1,210 Ω
NG
AC1
EAC
I041199E01
OK
AC
REPLACE STEERING PAD SWITCH RH
AC–133
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
4
INSPECT STEERING PAD SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Connect the steering pad switch RH and LH to the
steering pad switch cable.
(b) Measure the resistance of the connector.
Standard resistance
Steering Pad Switch Assembly
AC1
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
3 (AC1) - 7 (EAC)
Fr. DEF switch ON
Below 1 Ω
3 (AC1) - 7 (EAC)
Rr. DEF switch ON
300 Ω
3 (AC1) - 7 (EAC)
Recirculation/Fresh
switch ON
1,210 Ω
NG
REPLACE STEERING PAD SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
EAC
I039336E02
OK
AC
AC–134
5
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
INSPECT SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the spiral cable.
(b) Measure the resistance of the connectors.
Standard resistance
Steering Pad Switch Assembly
AC2
AC1
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
C12-3 (EAC) - 7 (EAC)
Below 1 Ω
C12-9 (AC2) - 2 (AC2)
Below 1 Ω
C12-10 (AC1) - 3 (AC1)
Below 1 Ω
EAC
NG
C12
AC2
AC1
EAC
I039337E20
OK
AC
REPLACE SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSEMBLY
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
6
AC–135
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (STEERING PAD SWITCH - AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER)
(a) Disconnect the C12 steering pad connector.
(b) Disconnect the A7 amplifier connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Steering Pad Switch
EAC
C12
Tester Connection
AC1
AC2
Air Conditioning Amplifier
A7
A7-2 (ST1) - C12-10 (AC1)
Below 1 Ω
A7-15 (SGST) - C12-3 (EAC)
Below 1 Ω
A7-1 (ST2) - C12-9 (AC2)
Below 1 Ω
A7-2 (ST1) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A7-15 (SGST) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A7-1 (ST2) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
SGST
Specified Condition
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
ST2
ST1
E127525E01
OK
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
AC
AC–136
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
IG Power Source Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This is the main power source supplied to the air conditioning amplifier when the power switch is turned
ON (IG). The power source supplied is used for operating the air conditioning amplifier, servo motor, etc.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Air Conditioning Amplifier
IG1
A/C (HTR)
IG
Power Source Control ECU
AM1
IGID
AM2
DC/DC
GND
P/I
MAIN
E125216E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
AC
1
INSPECT FUSE (A/C (HTR))
(a) Remove the A/C (HTR) fuse from the driver side junction
block.
AC–137
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
(b) Measure the resistance of the fuse.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE FUSE
OK
2
CHECK AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER (IG VOLTAGE)
(a) Remove the air conditioning amplifier with connectors
still connected.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
A8
IG
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
A8-5 (IG) - A8-1 (GND)
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
OK
GND
I041186E10
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NG
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER - BATTERY AND BODY
GROUND)
(a) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
A8
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
A8-5 (IG) - Body ground
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
IG
GND
E127522E05
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A8-1 (GND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
AC
AC–138
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
Back-up Power Source Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This is the back-up power source circuit for the air conditioning amplifier. Power is supplied even when
turning the power switch OFF and is used for diagnostic trouble code memory, etc.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Air Conditioning Amplifier
ECU-B
+B
DC/DC
MAIN
GND
E125217E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT FUSE (ECU-B)
(a) Remove the ECU-B fuse from the driver side junction
block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the fuse.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
OK
AC
REPLACE FUSE
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
2
AC–139
CHECK AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER (+B VOLTAGE)
(a) Remove the air conditioning amplifier with connectors
still connected.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
A8
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A8-6 (+B) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
OK
+B
I041186E11
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NG
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER - BATTERY AND BODY
GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the A8 amplifier connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
A8
+B
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A8-6 (+B) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
GND
E127522E06
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A8-1 (GND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
AC
AC–136
AIR CONDITIONING – REFRIGERANT
REFRIGERANT
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
Sight Glass
I038559E02
INSPECT REFRIGERANT PRESSURE WITH
MANIFOLD GAUGE SET
(a) Check the sight glass of the cooler unit refrigerant
liquid pipe E.
(1) Set the vehicle according to the conditions
below.
Item
Condition
All doors
Fully open
Temperature setting
MAX COLD
Blower speed
HI
A/C switch
ON
(2) Check the sight glass under these conditions.
Item
Symptom
Amount of refrigerant
Corrective Actions
1
Bubbles exist
Insufficient*
1. Check for gas leakage and
repair if necessary
2. Add refrigerant until bubbles
disappear
2
No bubbles exist (DTC 76 is
output)
Empty, insufficient or excessive
Refer to 3 and 4
3
No temperature difference
between compressor inlet and
outlet
Empty or nearly empty
1. Check for gas leakage and
repair if necessary
2. Add refrigerant until bubbles
disappear
4
Considerable temperature
difference between compressor
inlet and outlet
Proper or excessive
Refer to 5 and 6
5
Immediately after air conditioning
is turned off, refrigerant remains
clear
Excessive
1. Discharge refrigerant
2. Remove air and supply proper
amount of purified refrigerant
6
Immediately after air conditioning
is turned off, refrigerant foams
and then becomes clear
Proper
-
HINT:
Bubbles in the sight glass with the room
temperature higher than usual can be
considered normal if cooling is sufficient.
2.
AC
INSPECT REFRIGERANT PRESSURE WITH
MANIFOLD GAUGE SET
(a) This is a method in which the trouble is located by
using a manifold gauge set. Read the manifold
gauge pressure when these conditions are
established.
Gauge readings (Reference)
Test conditions:
• Temperature at the air inlet with the switch set at
RECIRC is 30 to 35°C (86 to 95°F)
• Blower speed control switch at "HI" position
• Temperature control switch at "MAX COLD"
position
• A/C switch ON
• Fully open doors
AC–137
AIR CONDITIONING – REFRIGERANT
(1) The refrigeration system functions normally
Gauge reading:
Low-pressure side:
0.15 to 0.25 MPa (1.5 to 2.5 kgf/cm2)
High-pressure side:
1.37 to 1.57 MPa (14 to 16 kgf/cm2)
(2) Moisture present in refrigeration system
E050573E01
Condition:
Periodically cools and then fails to cool.
I022117E19
Symptoms
Probable Cause
Diagnosis
Corrective Actions
During operation, pressure on
low-pressure side cycles between
normal and vacuum
Moisture in refrigerating system
freezes at expansion valve orifice,
causing a temporary stop of
cycle. However, when it melts,
normal state is restored.
- Cooler dryer in oversaturated
state
Moisture in refrigeration system
freezes at expansion valve orifice
and blocks circulation of
refrigerant
1. Replace cooler dryer
2. Remove moisture in cycle by
repeatedly evacuating air
3. Supply proper amount of new
refrigerant
(3) Insufficient cooling
Condition: Coolig system does not function effectively.
I022118E11
Symptoms
Probable Cause
Diagnosis
Corrective Actions
- Pressure is low on both low and
high-pressure sides
- Bubbles are continuously seen
through sight glass
- Insufficient cooling performance
Gas leakage in refrigeration
system
- Insufficient refrigerant
- Refrigerant leaking
1. Check for gas leakage and
repair if necessary
2. Supply proper amount of new
refrigerant
3. If the indicated pressure value
is close to 0 when connected to
the gauge, create a vacuum after
inspecting and repairing location
of leakage
AC
AC–138
AIR CONDITIONING – REFRIGERANT
(4) Poor circulation of refrigerant
Condition: Cooling system does not function effectively.
I022119E12
Symptoms
Probable Cause
Diagnosis
Corrective Actions
- Pressure low on both low and
high-pressure sides
- Frost exists on pipe from cooler
condenser to A/C unit
Refrigerant flow is obstructed by
dirt in cooler condenser core
Cooler condenser core is clogged
Replace cooler condenser core
(5) Refrigerant does not circulate
Condition: Cooling system does not function. (Sometimes it may function)
I022120E11
Symptoms
Probable Cause
Diagnosis
Corrective Actions
- Vacuum is indicated on lowpressure side and very low
pressure is indicated on highpressure side
- Frost or condensation is seen
on piping on both sides of cooler
condenser core or expansion
valve
- Refrigerant flow is obstructed by
moisture or dirt in refrigeration
system
- Refrigerant flow obstructed by
gas leaked from cooler expansion
valve
Refrigerant does not circulate
1. Check expansion valve
2. Clean out dirt in cooler
expansion valve by blowing air
3. Replace cooler condenser core
4. Evacuate and charge new
refrigerant
5. For gas leakage from cooler
expansion valve, replace cooler
expansion valve
(6) Refrigerant overcharged or insufficient cooling
of condenser
Condition: Cooling system does not function effectively.
I022121E09
AC
AC–139
AIR CONDITIONING – REFRIGERANT
Symptoms
Probable Cause
Diagnosis
Corrective Actions
- Pressure is too high on both low
and high-pressure sides
- No air bubbles are seen through
the sight glass when compressor
speed decreases
- Excessive refrigerant
- Insufficient cooling of cooler
condenser core
- Excessive refrigerant in cycle
(excessive refrigerant is supplied)
- Insufficient cooling of cooler
condenser core
1. Clean cooler condenser core
fins
2. Check cooling fan with
condenser fan motor operation
3. If 1 and 2 normal, check the
amount of refrigerant and supply
proper amount of refrigerant
(7) Air present in refrigeration system
Condition: Cooling system does not function.
NOTE: These gauge indications occur
when the refrigeration system opens
and the refrigerant is charged without
vacuum purging.
I022122E08
Symptoms
Probable Cause
Diagnosis
Corrective Actions
- Pressure is too high on both low
and high-pressure sides
- Low-pressure piping is too hot to
touch
Bubbles are seen through sight
glass
Air in system
- Air present in refrigeration
system
- Insufficient vacuum purging
1. Check compressor oil to see if
it is dirty or insufficient
2. Evacuate and charge new
refrigerant
(8) Expansion valve malfunction
Condition: Insufficient Cooling
I022123E13
Symptoms
Probable Cause
Diagnosis
Corrective Actions
- Pressure is too high on both low
and high-pressure sides
- Frost or large amount of
condensation on piping on lowpressure side
Trouble in cooler expansion valve
- Excessive refrigerant in low
pressure piping
- Cooler expansion valve is
opened too wide
Replace cooler expansion valve
AC
AC–140
AIR CONDITIONING – REFRIGERANT
(9) Defective compression in compressor
Condition: Insufficient Cooling
I022124E09
Symptoms
Probable Cause
Diagnosis
Corrective Actions
- Pressure is too high on both low
and high-pressure sides
- Pressure is too low on highpressure side
Internal leak in cooler compressor
- Compression failure
- Leakage from damaged valve or
broken sliding parts
Repair or replace compressor
Gauge readings (Reference)
Pressure on low-pressure side
MPa (kgf/cm2)
0.5 (5.0)
Blower HI Zone
0.4 (4.0)
1.06 (10.80)
0.3 (3.0)
0.27 (2.75)
0.2 (2.0)
1.2 (12.23)
Blower LO Zone
0.22 (2.24)
0.2 (2.03)
1.25 (12.74)
0.14 (1.42)
0.5 (5.0)
Pressure on highpressure side
1.32 (13.46)
1.0 (10.0)
1.5 (15.0)
2.0 (20.0)
MPa (kgf/cm2)
I030081E04
AC
AIR CONDITIONING – REFRIGERANT
AC–141
REPLACEMENT
1.
DISCHARGE REFRIGERANT FROM
REFRIGERATION SYSTEM
(a) Turn the A/C switch on.
(b) Operate the A/C with the setting temperature at 25
°C (77°F) and the blower level at LO for 10 minutes
to circulate the refrigerant, and collect compressor
oil remaining in each component into the cooler
compressor as much as possible.
(c) Stop the engine.
(d) Using SST, let the refrigerant gas out.
SST 07110-58060 (07117-58080, 07117-58090,
07117-78050, 07117-88060, 07117-88070,
07117-88080)
2.
CHARGE REFRIGERANT
(a) Perform vacuum purging using a vacuum pump.
(b) Charge refrigerant HFC-134a (R134a).
Amount:
450 +-30 g (15.9 +-1.1 oz.)
SST 07110-58060 (07117-58060, 07117-58070,
07117-58080, 07117-58090, 07117-78050,
07117-88060, 07117-88070, 07117-88080)
Amount to be charged
Charge 100 g (3.53 oz.)
Mean value in
proper range
+-50 g (+-1.8 oz.)
High
Pressure
Overcharged
Point where
bubbles disappear
Refrigerant Amount
Sub-cool system
I030082E09
NOTICE:
• Do not turn the A/C on before charging
refrigerant as the cooler compressor does
not work properly without any refrigerant.
Operating without any refrigerant causes it to
overheat.
AC
AC–142
AIR CONDITIONING – REFRIGERANT
• Approximately 100 g (3.53 oz.) of refrigerant
may need to be charged after bubbles
disappear. The refrigerant amount should be
checked by quantity, and not with the sight
glass.
HINT:
Prepare a service can to recharge the refrigerant if
using the refrigerant gas collected with the Freon
collection/recycling device because the collective
rate of the device is approximately 90%.
Drain Hose
Gas Leak Detector
N014519E04
AC
3.
WARM UP COMPRESSOR
(a) Turn the A/C switch on for at least 1 minute to warm
up the compressor.
NOTICE:
Be sure to warm up the compressor when
turning the A/C on after removing and installing
the cooler refrigerant lines (including the
compressor) to prevent damage to the
compressor.
4.
INSPECT LEAKAGE OF REFRIGERANT
(a) After recharging the refrigerant gas, inspect leakage
of refrigerant gas using a halogen leak detector.
(b) (b)After recharging the refrigerant gas, prepare the
vehicle for a refrigerant gas leakage check by
making sure the following conditions are met.
(1) The ignition switch is OFF.
(2) The vehicle is in a place with good air
ventilation and without any volatile gases, such
as evaporated gasoline or exhaust gas. The
detector is very sensitive to volatile gases. If
volatile gases are unavoidable, the vehicle
must be lifted up.
(3) Some refrigerant remains in the refrigerant
system.
(4) The compressor is OFF and its pressure is
approximately 392 to 588 kPa (4 to 6 kgf/cm2).
(c) Bring the gas leak detector close to the drain hose
with the detector's power off.
HINT:
• After the blower motor has stopped, leave the
cooling unit as it is for more than 15 minutes.
• Expose the gas leak detector sensor under the
drain hose.
• When bringing the gas leak detector close to the
drain hose, make sure that the gas leak detector
does not react to the volatile gases.
(d) If a gas leak is not detected on the drain hose,
remove the blower motor control from the cooling
unit. Insert the gas leak detector sensor into the unit
and perform the test.
AIR CONDITIONING – REFRIGERANT
AC–143
(e) Disconnect the pressure switch connector and wait
for approximately 20 minutes. Bring the gas leak
detector close to the pressure switch and perform
the test.
AC
AIR CONDITIONING – REFRIGERANT LINE
AC–143
REFRIGERANT LINE
HEATER
AIR
CONDITIONING
& AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
COMPONENTS
COOLER REFRIGERANT LIQUID PIPE E
SUCTION HOSE SUB-ASSEMBLY
PIPING CLAMP
(QUICK JOINT)
DISCHARGE HOSE
SUB-ASSEMBLY
9.8 (100, 87 in.*lbf)
5.4 (55, 49 in.*lbf)
ELECTRIC INVERTER
COMPRESSOR ASSEMBLY
CONDENSER ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
E118679E01
AC
AC–144
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
HEATER
AIR
CONDITIONING
& AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
COMPONENTS
DEFROSTER NOZZLE ASSEMBLY
NO. 1 SIDE DEFROSTER
NOZZLE DUCT
NO. 3 HEATER TO REGISTER DUCT
NO. 3 SIDE DEFROSTER NOZZLE DUCT
NO. 2 HEATER TO REGISTER DUCT
NO. 1 HEATER TO REGISTER DUCT
PIPING CLAMP
(QUICK JOINT)
SUCTION HOSE
SUB-ASSEMBLY
COOLER REFRIGERANT
LIQUID PIPE
PIPING CLAMP
(QUICK JOINT)
O-RING
O-RING
NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL
BRACE SUB-ASSEMBLY
AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
ASSEMBLY
Compressor oil ND-OIL 11 or equivalent
▲
BLOWER ASSEMBLY
Non-reusable part
AC
▲ Use repair screws (part No. 90159-70003) if the screws
removed before cannot be tightened.
NO. 3 AIR DUCT REAR
E118680E01
AC–145
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
PIPING CLAMP
PIPING CLAMP
DEFROSTER NOZZLE
ASSEMBLY LOWER
EXPANSION
VALVE COVER
HEATER RADIATOR UNIT SUB-ASSEMBLY
AIR CONDITIONING TUBE AND
ACCESSORY ASSEMBLY
NO. 1 COOLER EVAPORATOR
SUB-ASSEMBLY
COOLER EXPANSION
VALVE
O-RING
AIR OUTLET DAMPER
SERVO MOTOR
3.5 (35, 30 in.*lbf)
O-RING
HEATER PIPING
COVER
EVAPORATOR TEMPERATURE
SENSOR
AIR MIX CONTROL SERVO MOTOR
ASPIRATOR PIPE
QUICK HEATER ASSEMBLY
NO. 1 AIR DUCT
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
Compressor oil ND-OIL 11 or equivalent
AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
ASSEMBLY
E118681E01
AC
AC–146
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
REMOVAL
1.
DISCHARGE REFRIGERANT FROM
REFRIGERATION SYSTEM (See page AC-140)
2.
DISCONNECT SUCTION HOSE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Check SST installation direction.
SST 09870-00015
HINT:
Set SST so that the stopper side is on the piping
clamp lock side.
(b) Install SST on the piping clamp.
I003838E03
(c) Push down on SST with your thumb while holding
the pipe with both hands.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to bend the pipe.
(d) Pull SST until the stopper touches the pipe.
(e) Raise SST stopper and remove the piping clamp
with SST from the pipe.
(f) Remove the piping clamp from SST.
Pull
Push
SST
Release Lever
I003839E01
(g) Disconnect the suction hose by hand or using a
screwdriver.
(h) Remove the 2 O-rings from the suction hose.
NOTICE:
• Do not apply excessive force to the suction
hose.
• Seal the opening of the disconnected part
using vinyl tape to prevent moisture and
foreign matter from entering it.
Screw
driver
Disconnect the
hose by hand
I006919E11
Heater Water Hose A
Heater Water Hose B
AC
I038565E01
3.
DISCONNECT COOLER REFRIGERANT LIQUID PIPE
E (TO COOLER UNIT)
SST 09870-00025
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the suction
hose.
4.
DISCONNECT HEATER WATER HOSE B
(a) Slide the clip and disconnect the heater water hose
B.
NOTICE:
• Do not apply excessive force to the water
hose B.
• Prepare a drain pan or cloth for when the
cooling water leaks.
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
AC–147
5.
DISCONNECT HEATER WATER HOSE A
(a) Slide the clip and disconnect the heater water hose
A.
NOTICE:
• Do not apply excessive force to the water
hose A.
• Prepare a drain pan or cloth for when the
cooling water leaks.
6.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
WITH PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
HINT:
Refer to the removal procedures for the instrument panel
with the passenger airbag (see page IP-5).
7.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
LOWER
HINT:
Refer to the removal procedures for the instrument panel
lower (see page IP-17).
8.
REMOVE NO. 3 AIR DUCT REAR
(a) Fold back the floor carpet.
HINT:
Fold back the floor carpet so that the No. 3 air duct
rear can be removed.
(b) Detach the 10 claws and then remove the No. 3 air
duct rear.
9.
REMOVE NO. 3 HEATER TO REGISTER DUCT
(a) Remove the clip and No. 3 heater to register duct
with the No. 2 side defroster nozzle duct.
I038823E03
I038566E01
10. REMOVE NO. 1 HEATER TO REGISTER DUCT
(a) Remove the No. 1 duct with the No. 1 side defroster
nozzle duct.
I038567E01
AC
AC–148
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
11. REMOVE NO. 2 HEATER TO REGISTER DUCT
I038568E01
12. REMOVE DEFROSTER NOZZLE ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 clips.
(b) Detach the 3 claws and then remove the defroster
nozzle.
13. REMOVE TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU
ASSEMBLY
14. REMOVE ECM
15. REMOVE NETWORK GATEWAY ECU
I038569E03
16. REMOVE NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACE SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Detach the clamp and disconnect the harness.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts, nut and instrument panel
brace.
17. REMOVE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the air conditioning amplifier (see page
AC-179).
I039536E01
18. REMOVE STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the steering column (see page SR-7).
AC
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
AC–149
19. REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL REINFORCEMENT
ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect each connector and remove each
clamp. Disconnect the wire harness.
I038978E03
(b) Remove the 7 bolts, 2 nuts and then remove the
instrument panel reinforcement with the air
conditioner unit.
I038973E01
AC
AC–150
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
20. REMOVE AIR CONDITIONING UNIT ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the 5 connectors.
(b) Detach the 9 clamps and disconnect the wire
harness.
Clamp
I038974E03
(c) Remove the bolt.
(d) Detach the clamp and disconnect the junction
connector.
: Clamp
I038975E03
(e) Remove the 2 screws and air conditioning unit from
the instrument panel reinforcement.
I038976E01
DISASSEMBLY
1.
I038977E01
AC
REMOVE BLOWER ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 screws.
(b) Disengage the fittings with the air conditioner and
then remove the blower.
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
AC–151
2.
REMOVE DEFROSTER NOZZLE ASSEMBLY LOWER
(a) Detach the 2 claws and remove the defroster nozzle
lower.
3.
REMOVE AIR MIX CONTROL SERVO MOTOR
(a) Remove the 2 screws and air mix control servo
motor.
4.
REMOVE AIR OUTLET CONTROL SERVO MOTOR
(a) Remove the 2 screws and disengage the claw.
(b) Detach the claw and remove the air outlet control
servo motor.
5.
REMOVE AIR CONDITIONING TUBE AND
ACCESSORY ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 screws and expansion valve cover.
I038835E02
I038834E02
I038825E02
I038826E01
(b) Using a 4 mm hexagon wrench, remove the 2
hexagon bolts.
(c) Remove the air conditioning tube.
(d) Remove the 2 O-rings from the air conditioning tube
assembly.
AC
I038827E01
AC–152
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
6.
REMOVE COOLER EXPANSION VALVE
(a) Remove the cooler expansion valve from the No. 1
cooler evaporator.
7.
REMOVE HEATER RADIATOR UNIT SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Detach the clamp and disconnect the evaporator
temperature sensor connector.
(b) Detach the clamp and 2 claws, and remove the
heater piping cover.
I038828E01
: Clamp
I039537E02
(c) Remove the 4 screws and 4 clamps.
(d) Remove the radiator heater unit from the air
conditioner radiator.
NOTICE:
Prepare a drain pan or cloth for when the
cooling water leaks.
I038830E01
8.
I039539E01
AC
REMOVE NO. 1 AIR DUCT
(a) Remove the 2 screws and No. 1 air duct.
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
9.
AC–153
REMOVE QUICK HEATER ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 4 screws and quick heater.
I038833E01
10. REMOVE NO. 1 COOLER EVAPORATOR SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 7 screws and No. 1 cooler evaporator
from the heater case.
I038832E01
(b) Remove the 2 O-rings from the No. 1 cooler
evaporator.
E069079E01
11. REMOVE EVAPORATOR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
(a) Detach the 2 claws and remove the evaporator
temperature sensor.
I038987E02
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL EVAPORATOR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
(a) Install the evaporator temperature sensor and
attach the 2 claws.
AC
I038987E02
AC–154
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
2.
E069079E01
INSTALL NO. 1 COOLER EVAPORATOR SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Sufficiently apply compressor oil (ND-OIL 11) to 2
new O-rings and the fitting surface. Install the 2 Orings to the No. 1 cooler evaporator.
Compressor oil:
ND-OIL 11 or equivalent
NOTICE:
• Do not use any compressor oil other than NDOIL 11.
• If any compressor oil other than ND-OIL 11 is
used, compressor motor insulation
performance may decrease, resulting in a
leakage of electric power.
(b) Install the No. 1 cooler evaporator with the 7
screws.
I038832E01
3.
INSTALL QUICK HEATER ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the quick heater with the 4 screws.
4.
INSTALL NO. 1 AIR DUCT
(a) Install the No. 1 air duct with the 2 screws.
5.
INSTALL HEATER RADIATOR UNIT SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the air conditioning radiator to the radiator
heater unit.
I038833E01
I039539E01
AC
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
AC–155
(b) Install the 4 clamps and 4 screws.
I038830E01
(c) Attach the 2 claws and clamp to install the heater
piping cover.
(d) Attach the clamp and connect the evaporator
temperature sensor connector.
: Clamp
I039537E02
6.
INSTALL COOLER EXPANSION VALVE
(a) Install the cooler expansion valve to the No. 1 cooler
evaporator.
7.
INSTALL AIR CONDITIONING TUBE AND
ACCESSORY ASSEMBLY
(a) Sufficiently apply compressor oil (ND-OIL 11) to 2
new O-rings and the fitting surface. Install the 2 Orings to the air conditioning tube assembly.
Compressor oil:
ND-OIL 11 or equivalent
NOTICE:
• Do not use any compressor oil other than NDOIL 11.
• If any compressor oil other than ND-OIL 11 is
used, compressor motor insulation
performance may decrease, resulting in a
leakage of electric power.
I038828E01
I038827E01
AC
AC–156
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
(b) Install the air conditioning tube to the No. 1 cooler
evaporator, placing the cooler expansion valve
between them. Using a 4 mm (0.16 in.) hexagon
wrench, install the 2 hexagon bolts.
Torque: 3.5 N*m (35 kgf*cm, 30 in.*lbf)
(c) Install the expansion cover with the 2 screws.
I038826E01
8.
INSTALL AIR OUTLET CONTROL SERVO MOTOR
(a) Install the air outlet control servo motor and attach
the claw.
(b) Attach the claw and install the 2 screws.
9.
INSTALL AIR MIX CONTROL SERVO MOTOR
(a) Install the air mix control servo motor with the 2
screws.
I038825E02
I038834E02
10. INSTALL DEFROSTER NOZZLE ASSEMBLY LOWER
(a) Install the defroster nozzle lower and attach the 2
claws.
I038835E02
AC
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
AC–157
11. INSTALL BLOWER ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the blower and then attach the fittings with the
air conditioner.
(b) Install the 2 screws.
I038977E01
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL AIR CONDITIONING UNIT ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the air conditioning unit to the instrument
panel reinforcement with the 2 screws.
HINT:
Use repair screws (part No. 90159-70003) if the
screws removed before cannot be tightened.
I038976E01
(b) Attach the clamp to connect the junction connector.
(c) Install the bolt.
I038975E04
(d) Attach the 9 clamps to connect the instrument panel
wire harness.
(e) Connect the 5 connectors.
2.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL REINFORCEMENT
ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the instrument panel reinforcement with the 7
bolts.
I038974E04
AC
AC–158
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
(b) Install the 2 nuts to the air conditioning unit and
temporarily tighten them.
I038973E01
(c) Connect each connector and install each clamp.
Then connect the wire harness.
I038978E04
AC
3.
INSTALL AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the air conditioning amplifier (see page AC179).
4.
INSTALL STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the steering column (see page SR-12).
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
AC–159
5.
INSTALL NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACE SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Install the instrument panel brace with the 2 bolts
and nut.
(b) Attach the clamp to connect the harness.
6.
FULLY TIGHTEN AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
ASSEMBLY
(a) Fully tighten the air conditioning unit with the 2 nuts.
NOTICE:
Tighten the nuts in the order indicated in the
illustration.
7.
INSTALL NETWORK GATEWAY ECU
8.
INSTALL ECM
9.
INSTALL TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU
ASSEMBLY
I039536E01
(1)
(2)
I040423E04
10. INSTALL DEFROSTER NOZZLE ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the defroster nozzle and attach the 3 claws.
(b) Install the 2 clips.
I038569E04
11. INSTALL NO. 2 HEATER TO REGISTER DUCT
12. INSTALL NO. 1 HEATER TO REGISTER DUCT
(a) Install the duct with the No. 1 side defroster nozzle
duct.
13. INSTALL NO. 3 HEATER TO REGISTER DUCT
(a) Install the clip and then the duct with the No. 2 side
defroster nozzle duct.
I038568E01
14. INSTALL NO. 3 AIR DUCT REAR
(a) Attach the 10 claws to install the No. 3 air duct rear.
(b) Return the carpet to its original position.
15. INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
LOWER
HINT:
Refer to the installation procedures for the instrument
panel lower (see page IP-20).
AC
AC–160
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
16. INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
WITH PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
HINT:
Refer to the installation procedures for the instrument
panel with the passenger airbag (see page IP-11).
17. CONNECT HEATER WATER HOSE A
(a) Connect the heater water hose A and slide the clip.
Heater Water Hose A
Heater Water Hose B
I038565E01
19. CONNECT COOLER REFRIGERANT LIQUID PIPE E
(TO COOLER UNIT)
(a) Remove the attached vinyl tape from the pipe's
disconnected part.
(b) Sufficiently apply compressor oil (ND-OIL 11) to 2
new O-rings and the pipe's connecting part.
NOTICE:
• Do not use any compressor oil other than NDOIL 11 (see page ).
• If any compressor oil other than ND-OIL 11 is
used, compressor motor insulation
performance may decrease, resulting in a
leakage of electric power.
(c) Install the O-rings to the pipe.
(d) Insert the pipe joint into the cooler unit fitting hole
securely.
(e) Using the piping clamp, connect the cooler unit
refrigerant liquid pipe E.
NOTICE:
Ensure that the piping clamp is securely
engaged.
INCORRECT
CORRECT
18. CONNECT HEATER WATER HOSE B
(a) Connect the heater water hose B and slide the clip.
GAP
20. CONNECT SUCTION HOSE SUB-ASSEMBLY
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the cooler unit
refrigerant liquid pipe E.
I006878E08
21. INSPECT LEAKAGE OF REFRIGERANT (See page
AC-142)
22. ADD ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-7)
23. CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS (See page
CO-9)
24. WARM UP COMPRESSOR (See page AC-142)
25. INSPECT LEAKAGE OF REFRIGERANT (See page
AC-142)
26. PERFORM CALIBRATION
(a) Perform calibration (see page PS-13).
AC
AC–161
AIR CONDITIONING – BLOWER UNIT
BLOWER UNIT
HEATER
AIR
CONDITIONING
& AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
COMPONENTS
BLOWER ASSEMBLY
AIR DUCT SUB-ASSEMBLY
AIR INLET SERVO
MOTOR
CLEAN AIR FILTER
BLOWER MOTOR
CONTROL
AIR FILTER COVER PLATE
NO. 2 COOLER WIRING HARNESS
SUB-ASSEMBLY
BLOWER MOTOR COVER
Use a repair screw (part No. 90159-70003) if the screw removed before cannot be tightened
E118682E01
AC
AC–162
AIR CONDITIONING – BLOWER UNIT
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
WITH PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
HINT:
Refer to the removal procedures for the instrument panel
with the passenger airbag (see page IP-5).
2.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
LOWER
HINT:
Refer to the removal procedures for the instrument panel
lower (see page IP-17).
3.
REMOVE TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU
ASSEMBLY
4.
REMOVE ECM
5.
REMOVE NETWORK GATEWAY ECU
6.
REMOVE NO. 1 HEATER TO REGISTER DUCT
7.
REMOVE AIR DUCT SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 screws and air duct.
8.
REMOVE BLOWER ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the 10 connectors.
(b) Detach the 4 clamps and disconnect the wire
harness.
I040426E01
AC
Clamp
I038839E03
AIR CONDITIONING – BLOWER UNIT
AC–163
(c) Remove the 3 screws, nut and blower.
I038841E01
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE AIR INLET SERVO MOTOR
(a) Remove the 3 screws and air inlet servo motor.
2.
REMOVE BLOWER MOTOR CONTROL
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the 2 screws and blower motor control.
3.
REMOVE NO. 2 COOLER WIRING HARNESS SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 5 screws and blower motor cover.
I038843E01
I038844E01
I038845E01
(b) Remove the No. 2 cooler wiring harness from the
blower with fan motor.
AC
I038847E01
AC–164
AIR CONDITIONING – BLOWER UNIT
4.
REMOVE BLOWER WITH FAN MOTOR SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 3 screws and blower with fan motor.
5.
REMOVE CLEAN AIR FILTER
(a) Detach the 2 claws and then remove the air filter
cover plate with the clean air filter.
(b) Remove the clean air filter from the air filter cover
plate.
I038846E01
I038848E02
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL CLEAN AIR FILTER
(a) Install the clean air filter to the air filter cover plate.
(b) Attach the 2 claws to install the air filter cover.
2.
INSTALL BLOWER WITH FAN MOTOR SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Install the blower with fan motor with the 3 screws.
3.
INSTALL NO. 2 COOLER WIRING HARNESS SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Install the No. 2 cooler wiring harness to the blower
with fan motor.
I038848E02
I038846E01
AC
I038847E01
AIR CONDITIONING – BLOWER UNIT
AC–165
(b) Install the blower motor cover with the 5 screws.
I038845E01
4.
INSTALL BLOWER MOTOR CONTROL
(a) Install the blower motor control with the 2 screws.
(b) Connect the connector.
5.
INSTALL AIR INLET SERVO MOTOR
(a) Install the air inlet servo motor with the 3 screws.
I038844E01
I038843E01
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL BLOWER ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the blower with the 3 screws.
HINT:
Use a repair screw (part No. 90159-70003) if the
screw (A) removed before cannot be tightened.
(A)
I038841E02
AC
AC–166
AIR CONDITIONING – BLOWER UNIT
(b) Attach the 4 clamps to connect the wire harness.
(c) Connect the connectors.
(d) Install the 10 connectors of the transponder key
ECU.
Clamp
AC
2.
INSTALL AIR DUCT SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the air duct with the 2 screws.
3.
INSTALL NO. 1 HEATER TO REGISTER DUCT
4.
INSTALL NETWORK GATEWAY ECU
5.
INSTALL ECU
6.
INSTALL TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU
ASSEMBLY
7.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
LOWER
HINT:
Refer to the installation procedures for the instrument
panel sub-assembly lower (see page )IP-20.
8.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
WITH PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
HINT:
Refer to the installation procedures for the instrument
panel with the passenger airbag assembly (see page IP11).
I038839E03
AIR CONDITIONING – ELECTRIC INVERTER COMPRESSOR
AC–167
ELECTRIC INVERTER
COMPRESSOR
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD
2.
REMOVE DECK FLOOR BOX REAR
3.
REMOVE REAR NO.3 FLOOR BOARD
4.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
5.
REMOVE SERVICE PLUG GRIP
6.
DISCHARGE REFRIGERANT FROM
REFRIGERATION SYSTEM (See page AC-140)
7.
DISCONNECT DISCHARGE HOSE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the bolt and disconnect the discharge
hose.
(b) Remove the O-ring from the discharge hose.
NOTICE:
Seal the openings of the disconnected parts of
the discharge hose and electric inverter
compressor assembly using vinyl tape to
prevent moisture and foreign matter from
entering them.
8.
DISCONNECT SUCTION HOSE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the bolt and disconnect the suction hose.
(b) Remove the O-ring from the suction hose.
NOTICE:
Seal the openings of the disconnected parts of
the suction hose and electric inverter
compressor assembly using vinyl tape to
prevent moisture and foreign matter from
entering them.
9.
REMOVE ELECTRIC INVERTER COMPRESSOR
ASSEMBLY
(a) Release the green-colored lock. (1)
(b) Disconnect the connector. (2)
(c) Detach the 3 clamps and disconnect the wire
harness.
NOTICE:
• Wear insulated gloves when performing the
procedures.
• Insulate the connector by sealing it with tape.
I038560E02
I038561E01
(1)
(2)
AC
I038562E03
AC–168
AIR CONDITIONING – ELECTRIC INVERTER COMPRESSOR
(d) Remove the 3 bolts and electric inverter
compressor.
I038563E01
INSTALLATION
Service
Valve
1.
INSPECT COMPRESSOR OIL
(a) Gradually discharge inert gas (helium) from the
service valve when replacing the electric inverter
compressor with a new one. Drain the following
amount of oil from the new electric inverter
compressor before installation.
Standard amount:
(Oil capacity inside new electric inverter
compressor 100 + 15 cc (3.52 + 0.53 fl.oz.)) (Remaining oil amount in the removed
compressor assembly with the motor (with
motor compressor assembly)) = (Oil amount to
be removed before installation)
NOTICE:
• Observe the precautions on the cooler
removal/installation procedures when
checking the amount of compressor oil.
• Because compressor oil remains in the pipes
of the vehicle, if a new compressor is
installed without removing the oil inside, the
amount of oil becomes too great, preventing
heat exchange in the refrigerant cycles and
causing refrigerant failure and/or abnormal
vibration.
• Check for oil leakage if the remaining oil
amount in the removed compressor is too
low.
• If any compressor oil other than ND-OIL 11 is
used, compressor motor insulation
performance may decrease, resulting in a
leakage of electric power.
2.
INSTALL ELECTRIC INVERTER COMPRESSOR
ASSEMBLY
(a) Temporarily install the compressor with the 2 bolts.
NOTICE:
Install the bolts in the order indicated in the
illustration.
Service
Valve
I039541E01
(1)
AC
(2)
E072576E02
AIR CONDITIONING – ELECTRIC INVERTER COMPRESSOR
AC–169
(b) Fully install the compressor with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 25 N*m (255 kgf*cm, 18 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Tighten them in the order indicated in the
illustration.
(2)
(1)
I041159E02
(c) Install the remaining bolt.
Torque: 25 N*m (255 kgf*cm, 18 ft.*lbf)
I041160E01
(2)
(d) Connect the wire harness.
NOTICE:
Wear insulated gloves when performing the
procedures.
(1) Connect the 3 wire harness clamps.
(2) Connect the connector. (1)
(3) Lock the green-colored lock. (2)
(1)
I041121E03
3.
I038561E01
INSTALL SUCTION HOSE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Sufficiently apply compressor oil to a new O-ring
and the fitting surface of the electric inverter
compressor assembly.
Compressor oil:
ND-OIL 11 or equivalent
NOTICE:
• Do not use any compressor oil other than NDOIL 11.
• If any compressor oil other than ND-OIL 11 is
used, compressor motor insulation
performance may decrease, resulting in a
leakage of electric power.
(b) Install the O-ring to the suction hose.
(c) Install the suction hose with the bolt.
Torque: 9.8 N*m (100 kgf*cm, 87 in.*lbf)
AC
AC–170
AIR CONDITIONING – ELECTRIC INVERTER COMPRESSOR
4.
INSTALL DISCHARGE HOSE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Sufficiently apply compressor oil to a new O-ring
and the fitting surface of the electric inverter
compressor.
Compressor oil:
ND-OIL 11 or equivalent
NOTICE:
• Do not use any compressor oil other than NDOIL 11.
• If any compressor oil other than ND-OIL 11 is
used, compressor motor insulation
performance may decrease, resulting in a
leakage of electric power.
(b) Install the O-ring to the discharge hose.
(c) Install the discharge hose with the bolt.
Torque: 9.8 N*m (100 kgf*cm, 87 in.*lbf)
5.
INSTALL SERVICE PLUG GRIP
6.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
7.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
8.
INSTALL REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD
9.
INSTALL DECK FLOOR BOX REAR
I038560E01
10. INSTALL REAR NO.2 FLOOR BOARD
11. CHARGE REFRIGERANT (See page AC-141)
12. WARM UP COMPRESSOR (See page AC-142)
13. INSPECT LEAKAGE OF REFRIGERANT (See page
AC-142)
AC
AC–171
AIR CONDITIONING – CONDENSER
CONDENSER
HEATER
AIR
CONDITIONING
& AIR CONDITIONING SYSTEM
COMPONENTS
NO. 1 INVERTER
BRACKET
RADIATOR SUPPORT UPPER
SUCTION BRACKET
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
HOOD LOCK ASSEMBLY
RADIATOR SUPPORT
SUB-ASSEMBLY UPPER LH
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
3.9 (40, 35 in.*lbf)
RADIATOR SUPPORT SUBASSEMBLY UPPER RH
ANGLE
CONDENSER ASSEMBLY
(WITH RECEIVER)
5.4 (55, 49 in.*lbf)
DISCHARGE HOSE
SUB-ASSEMBLY
3.9 (40, 35 in.*lbf)
COOLER REFRIGERANT LIQUID
PIPE E (TO COOLER UNIT)
3.9 (40, 35 in.*lbf)
5.4 (55, 49 in.*lbf)
COOLER DRYER
O-RING
CAP
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
2.9 (30, 25 in.*lbf)
Compressor oil ND-OIL 11 or equivalent
Non-reusable part
E118683E03
AC
AC–172
AIR CONDITIONING – CONDENSER
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
AC
1.
INSPECT COOLER CONDENSER CORE
(a) If the fins of the condenser (with receiver) are dirty,
clean them with water and dry them with
compressed air.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the fins of the cooler condenser
core.
(b) If the fins of the condenser (with receiver) are bent,
straighten them using a screwdriver or pliers.
2.
INSPECT LEAKAGE OF REFRIGERANT
(a) Using a halogen leak detector, check the pipe joints
for gas leakage.
(b) Check the tightening torque of the joint if gas
leakage is detected in a pipe joint.
AIR CONDITIONING – CONDENSER
AC–173
REMOVAL
1.
DISCHARGE REFRIGERANT FROM
REFRIGERATION SYSTEM (See page AC-140)
2.
REMOVE FRONT FENDER LINER LH (See page ET-3)
3.
REMOVE FRONT FENDER LINER RH (See page ET-3)
4.
REMOVE FRONT BUMPER COVER
(a) Remove the front bumper cover (see page ET-3).
5.
REMOVE NO. 1 INVERTER BRACKET
6.
DISCONNECT DISCHARGE HOSE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the bolt and disconnect the discharge hose
from the condenser (with receiver).
(b) Remove the O-ring from the discharge hose.
NOTICE:
Seal the openings of the disconnected parts of
the discharge hose and the condenser using
vinyl tape to prevent moisture and foreign
matter from entering them.
7.
DISCONNECT COOLER REFRIGERANT LIQUID PIPE
E (TO COOLER UNIT)
(a) Remove the bolt and disconnect the cooler unit
refrigerant liquid pipe E from the condenser (with
receiver).
(b) Remove the O-ring from the cooler refrigerant liquid
pipe E.
NOTICE:
Seal the openings of the disconnected parts of
the cooler unit refrigerant liquid pipe E and the
condenser using vinyl tape to prevent moisture
and foreign matter from entering them.
8.
REMOVE RADIATOR SUPPORT SUB-ASSEMBLY
UPPER RH
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and radiator support upper.
I038554E01
I038555E01
I038556E01
AC
AC–174
AIR CONDITIONING – CONDENSER
9.
REMOVE RADIATOR SUPPORT SUB-ASSEMBLY
UPPER LH
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and radiator support upper.
I038982E01
10. REMOVE CONDENSER ASSEMBLY WITH RECEIVER
(a) Remove the 2 angles.
I038557E01
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and condenser (with receiver).
I038558E01
DISASSEMBLY
1.
14 mm
Hexagon
Wrench
REMOVE COOLER DRYER
(a) Using a 14 mm hexagon wrench, remove the cap
from the modulator.
Modulator
I032993E05
(b) Remove the O-ring from the cap.
AC
I032475E01
AIR CONDITIONING – CONDENSER
AC–175
(c) Using pliers, remove the cooler dryer.
I032994E01
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL COOLER DRYER
(a) Using pliers, install the cooler dryer to the
modulator.
(b) Install a new O-ring to the cap.
I032994E01
(c) Sufficiently apply compressor oil (ND-OIL 11) to the
O-ring and cap fitting surface.
Compressor oil:
ND-OIL 11 or equivalent
NOTICE:
• Do not use any compressor oil other than NDOIL 11 (see page 55-1).
• If any compressor oil other than ND-OIL 11 is
used, compressor motor insulation
performance may decrease, resulting in a
leakage of electric power.
E055408E02
(d) Using a 14 mm hexagon wrench, install the cap to
the modulator.
Torque: 2.9 N*m (30 kgf*cm, 25 in.*lbf)
14 mm
Hexagon
Wrench
Modulator
I032993E05
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL CONDENSER ASSEMBLY WITH RECEIVER
(a) Install the condenser (with receiver) with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 3.9 N*m (40 kgf*cm, 35 in.*lbf)
AC
I038558E01
AC–176
AIR CONDITIONING – CONDENSER
(b) Install the 2 angles to the condenser (with receiver).
I038557E01
(A)
(C)(A)
2.
INSTALL RADIATOR SUPPORT SUB-ASSEMBLY
UPPER RH
(a) Install the radiator support upper with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 5.0 N*m (51 kgf*cm, 44 in.*lbf) for bolt A
3.9 N*m (40 kgf*cm, 35 in.*lbf) for bolt B
7.5 N*m (76 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf) for bolt C
3.
INSTALL RADIATOR SUPPORT SUB-ASSEMBLY
UPPER LH
(a) Install the radiator support upper with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 5.0 N*m (51 kgf*cm, 44 in.*lbf) for bolt A
3.9 N*m (40 kgf*cm, 35 in.*lbf) for bolt B
7.5 N*m (76 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf) for bolt C
4.
CONNECT COOLER REFRIGERANT LIQUID PIPE E
(TO COOLER UNIT)
(a) Remove the attached vinyl tape from the
disconnected parts of the cooler refrigerant liquid
pipe E and condenser assembly (with receiver).
(b) Install a new O-ring to the cooler refrigerant liquid
pipe E.
(c) Sufficiently apply compressor oil (ND-OIL 11) to the
O-ring and the cooler refrigerant liquid pipe E fitting
surface.
Compressor oil:
ND-OIL 11 or equivalent
NOTICE:
• Do not use any compressor oil other than NDOIL 11.
• If any compressor oil other than ND-OIL 11 is
used, compressor motor insulation
performance may decrease, resulting in a
leakage of electric power.
(B)
I038556E02
(A)
(C)(A)
(B)
I038982E02
AC
AIR CONDITIONING – CONDENSER
AC–177
(d) Connect the cooler refrigerant liquid pipe E to the
condenser (with receiver) with the bolt.
Torque: 5.4 N*m (55 kgf*cm, 47 in.*lbf)
5.
I038555E01
CONNECT DISCHARGE HOSE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the attached vinyl tape from the
disconnected parts of the discharge hose and the
condenser (with receiver).
(b) Install a new O-ring to the discharge hose.
(c) Sufficiently apply compressor oil (ND-OIL 11) to the
O-ring and the discharge hose fitting surface.
NOTICE:
• Do not use any compressor oil other than NDOIL 11.
• If any compressor oil other than ND-OIL 11 is
used, compressor motor insulation
performance may decrease, resulting in a
leakage of electric power.
(d) Connect the discharge hose to the condenser (with
receiver) with the bolt.
Torque: 5.4 N*m (55 kgf*cm, 47 in.*lbf)
I038554E01
6.
INSTALL NO. 1 INVERTER BRACKET
7.
INSTALL FRONT BUMPER COVER
(a) Install the front bumper cover (see page ET-6).
8.
INSTALL FRONT FENDER LINER RH (See page ET-7)
9.
INSTALL FRONT FENDER LINER LH (See page ET-7)
10. CHARGE REFRIGERANT (See page AC-141)
11. WARM UP COMPRESSOR (See page AC-142)
12. INSPECT LEAKAGE OF REFRIGERANT (See page
AC-142)
AC
AIR CONDITIONING – HEATER WATER PUMP
AC–177
HEATER WATER PUMP
REMOVAL
1.
Clamp
DISCONNECT HEATER WATER HOSE C
(a) Detach the clamp and disconnect the wire harness.
I038851E02
(b) Slide the hose clip and then disconnect the heater
water hose C.
NOTICE:
• Do not apply excessive force to the heater
water hose C.
• Prepare a drain pan or cloth for when the
cooling water leaks.
I038852E01
2.
REMOVE HEATER WATER PUMP ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and then disconnect the heater
water pump.
I038969E01
(c) Slide the hose clip and then disconnect the heater
water hose A.
(d) Remove the heater water pump.
NOTICE:
• Do not apply excessive force to the heater
water hose A.
• Prepare a drain pan or cloth for when the
cooling water leaks.
I038968E01
INSTALLATION
Groove
1.
INSTALL HEATER WATER PUMP ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the heater water hose A with the hose clip.
NOTICE:
• Ensure that the hose groove faces upwards.
• Install the hose clip in the direction shown in
the illustration.
AC
I038971E03
AC–178
AIR CONDITIONING – HEATER WATER PUMP
(b) Install the heater water pump with the 2 bolts.
NOTICE:
Tighten them in the order indicated in the
illustration.
(c) Connect the connector.
(1)
(2)
I038969E02
2.
Pink
Mark
INSTALL HEATER WATER HOSE C
(a) Install the heater water hose C with the hose clip.
NOTICE:
• Install the hose marking facing upwards.
• Install the hose clip in the direction shown in
the illustration.
I038970E03
(b) Connect the wire harness and attach the clamp.
I038851E03
AC
3.
ADD ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-7)
4.
CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS (See page
CO-9)
AIR CONDITIONING – AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
AC–179
AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL
LOWER CENTER (See page IP-18)
2.
REMOVE NO. 3 AIR DUCT REAR
3.
REMOVE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the 2 screws and air conditioning amplifier.
I038972E01
INSTALLATION
I038972E01
1.
INSTALL AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the air conditioning amplifier with the 2
screws.
(b) Connect the connector.
2.
INSTALL NO. 3 AIR DUCT REAR
3.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL
LOWER CENTER (See page IP-21)
AC
AH–1
AXLE – AXLE SYSTEM
AXLE SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
Use the table below to help determine the cause of the
problem symptom. The potential causes of the symptoms are
listed in order of probability in the "Suspected area" column of
the table. Check each symptom by checking the suspected
areas in the order they are listed. Replace parts as
necessary.
Symptom
Symptom
Wanders
Front wheel shimmy
Noise (Front)
Noise (Rear)
Suspected area
See page
1. Tire (improper air pressure, uneven wear)
-
2. Wheel alignment (Front)
SP-2
3. Wheel alignment (Rear)
SP-10
4. Hub bearing
AH-4
5. Front shock absorber with coil spring
SP-14
6. Rear shock absorber with coil spring
SP-33
1. Wheel (unbalance)
-
2. Hub bearing
AH-4
3. Front lower ball joint
SP-24
4. Front shock absorber with coil spring
SP-14
1. Front shock absorber with coil spring
SP-14
2. Front drive shaft
DS-7
3. Hub bearing
AH-4
4. Front lower ball joint
SP-24
1. Hub bearing
AH-4
2. Rear shock absorber with coil spring
SP-33
AH
AH–2
AXLE – FRONT AXLE HUB BOLT
FRONT AXLE HUB BOLT
REMOVAL
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
2.
DISCONNECT FRONT DISC BRAKE CALIPER
ASSEMBLY LH (See page AH-4)
3.
REMOVE FRONT DISC
HINT:
Put matchmarks on the front disc and front axle hub.
4.
REMOVE FRONT AXLE HUB BOLT LH
(a) Temporarily install 2 nuts to any 2 hub bolts, except
the hub bolt that you will replace.
(b) Using SST and a screwdriver or equivalent to hold
the front axle, remove the hub bolt that needs to be
replaced.
SST 09628-10011
SST
Hold
Turn
F047453E01
AH
1.
AXLE – FRONT AXLE HUB BOLT
AH–3
INSTALLATION
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
INSTALL FRONT AXLE HUB BOLT LH
(a) Insert a new hub bolt into the bolt hole. Set a plate
washer and nut on the hub bolt end.
(b) Using a screwdriver or equivalent to hold the front
axle, install the hub bolt by tightening the nut. Then
remove the nut and plate washer.
(c) Remove the 2 temporary nuts.
HINT:
A plate washer of 5 mm (0.21 in.) or more in
thickness is preferable.
Plate Washer
Hold
2.
INSTALL FRONT DISC
HINT:
Align the matchmarks of the front disc and front axle hub
before installing them.
3.
INSTALL FRONT DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSEMBLY
LH (See page AH-7)
4.
INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
Torque: 103 N*m (1,050 kgf*cm, 76 ft.*lbf)
Turn
F047454E01
AH
AH–3
AXLE – FRONT AXLE HUB
FRONT AXLE HUB
SUSPENSION & AXLE
AXLE
COMPONENTS
FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER LH
153 (1,560, 113)
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
FRONT SPEED SENSOR LH
STEERING KNUCKLE WITH AXLE HUB
CLIP
49 (500, 36)
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT LH
TIE ROD END
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
109 (1114, 81)
FRONT DISC
216 (2,200, 159)
FRONT DISC BRAKE
CALIPER ASSEMBLY LH
×5
89 (908, 66)
56 (571, 41)
FRONT AXLE HUB LH NUT
FRONT AXLE HUB BOLT
STEERING KNUCKLE LH
FRONT NO. 1 WHEEL
BEARING DUST
DEFLECTOR LH
AH
DISC BRAKE DUST
COVER FRONT LH
CLIP
71 (724, 52)
LOWER BALL JOINT ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
FRONT AXLE HUB SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
Non-reusable part
B133191E01
AH–4
AXLE – FRONT AXLE HUB
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT FRONT AXLE HUB BEARING LOOSENESS
(a) Remove the front wheel.
(b) Remove the front disc brake caliper.
(c) Remove the front disc.
HINT:
Put matchmarks on the front disc and front axle hub.
(d) Using a dial indicator, check for looseness at the
center of the axle hub.
Maximum looseness:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
If the looseness exceeds the maximum, replace the
axle hub.
2.
INSPECT FRONT AXLE HUB RUNOUT
(a) Using a dial indicator, check for runout of the axle
hub.
Maximum runout:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
If the runout exceeds the maximum, replace the
axle hub.
(b) Install the front disc.
HINT:
Align the matchmarks of the front disc and front axle
hub before installing them.
(c) Install the front disc brake caliper.
Torque: 109 N*m (1,114 kgf*cm, 81 ft.*lbf)
(d) Install the front wheel.
Torque: 103 N*m (1,050 kgf*cm, 76 ft.*lbf)
F046834E01
F046835E01
AH
AXLE – FRONT AXLE HUB
AH–5
REMOVAL
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
2.
REMOVE FRONT AXLE HUB NUT LH (See page DS5)
3.
DISCONNECT FRONT SPEED SENSOR LH (See page
BC-218)
4.
DISCONNECT FRONT DISC BRAKE CALIPER
ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and disconnect the disc brake
caliper from the steering knuckle.
NOTICE:
Hang down the disc brake caliper with a wire or
equivalent.
5.
REMOVE FRONT DISC
NOTICE:
Ensure no oil attaches to the disc surface.
6.
DISCONNECT TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(See page DS-6)
7.
DISCONNECT NO. 1 FRONT SUSPENSION ARM
SUB-ASSEMBLY LOWER LH (See page DS-6)
8.
REMOVE FRONT AXLE ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Using a plastic-faced hammer, tap the end of the
front drive shaft and disengage the fitting between
the front drive shaft and front axle.
HINT:
If it is difficult to disengage, tap the end of the front
drive shaft with a brass bar and hammer.
(b) Push the front axle outward from the vehicle to
remove the front drive shaft from the front axle.
NOTICE:
• Be careful not to push the front axle outward
from the vehicle more than is necessary to
remove it.
• Be careful not to damage the drive shaft
outboard joint boot.
• Be careful not to damage the speed sensor
rotor.
• Hang the front drive shaft down with a string
or equivalent.
C067088E05
AH
AH–6
AXLE – FRONT AXLE HUB
(c) Remove the 2 bolts and 2 nuts, and remove the
front axle from the front shock absorber.
C094903E01
9.
REMOVE FRONT NO. 1 WHEEL BEARING DUST
DEFLECTOR LH
(a) Mount the steering knuckle in a soft vise.
(b) Using a screwdriver, remove the deflector from the
steering knuckle.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the steering knuckle.
G028520E01
SST
Turn
F046084E03
10. REMOVE LOWER BALL JOINT ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the clip and castle nut.
(b) Using SST, remove the lower ball joint.
SST 09611-36020
NOTICE:
• Do not damage the steering knuckle.
• Securely hang SST to the spacer of the
steering knuckle.
• Replace the steering knuckle with a new one
if the spacer comes off the steering knuckle.
11. REMOVE FRONT AXLE HUB SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the 4 bolts, dust cover and front axle hub.
AH
G028521E01
AXLE – FRONT AXLE HUB
AH–7
INSTALLATION
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
INSTALL FRONT AXLE HUB SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the axle hub and dust cover with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 56 N*m (571 kgf*cm, 41 ft.*lbf)
2.
INSTALL LOWER BALL JOINT ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the lower ball joint to the steering knuckle,
and install the castle nut.
Torque: 71 N*m (724 kgf*cm, 52 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
• Be careful that grease does not adhere to the
threads or tapered part.
• The clip hole alignment should be done after
tightening the castle nut up to 60° beyond the
torque specification.
(b) Install a new clip.
3.
INSTALL FRONT NO. 1 WHEEL BEARING DUST
DEFLECTOR LH
(a) Using SST and a press, press in a new dust
deflector.
SST 09950-70010 (09951-07150), 09608-32010,
09950-60020 (09951-00720)
NOTICE:
Align the dust deflector hole and the steering
knuckle hole.
4.
INSTALL FRONT AXLE ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the front axle to the shock absorber, insert the
2 bolts from the front of the vehicle and tighten the 2
nuts.
Torque: 153 N*m (1,560 kgf*cm, 113 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Apply engine oil to the nut threads or the
seating surface only when reusing the bolt and
nuts.
(b) Push the front axle outward from the vehicle to
engage the spline of the drive shaft and insert it to
the front axle.
NOTICE:
• Be careful not to push the front axle outward
from the vehicle more than is necessary to
remove it.
• Be careful not to damage the drive shaft
outboard joint boot.
• Be careful not to damage the speed sensor
rotor.
• Check for any foreign matter on the speed
sensor rotor and insertion part.
SST
SST
F047905E01
C094903E01
AH
AH–8
AXLE – FRONT AXLE HUB
5.
CONNECT FRONT NO. 1 SUSPENSION ARM SUBASSEMBLY LOWER LH (See page DS-16)
6.
CONNECT TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY LH (See
page DS-16)
7.
INSTALL FRONT DISC
8.
INSTALL FRONT DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSEMBLY
LH
(a) Install the disc brake caliper to the steering knuckle
with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 109 N*m (1,114 kgf*cm, 81 ft.*lbf)
9.
INSTALL FRONT AXLE HUB LH NUT
(a) Using a 30 mm socket wrench, install a new hub
nut.
Torque: 216 N*m (2,200 kgf*cm, 159 ft.*lbf)
C067088E05
10. DISCONNECT FRONT DISC BRAKE CALIPER
ASSEMBLY LH
11. REMOVE FRONT DISC
12. INSPECT FRONT AXLE HUB BEARING LOOSENESS
(See page AH-4)
13. INSPECT FRONT AXLE HUB BEARING RUNOUT
(See page AH-4)
14. INSTALL FRONT DISC (See page BR-43)
15. INSTALL FRONT DISC BRAKE CALIPER ASSEMBLY
LH
Torque: 109 N*m (1,114 kgf*cm, 81 ft.*lbf)
16. INSTALL FRONT SPEED SENSOR LH (See page BC218)
17. INSTALL FRONT AXLE HUB NUT LH
(a) Using a chisel and hammer, stake the hub nut.
18. INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
Torque: 103 N*m (1,050 kgf*cm, 76 ft.*lbf)
AH
19. INSPECT AND ADJUST FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
(See page SP-3)
20. CHECK ABS SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL (See page BC219)
AH–8
AXLE – REAR AXLE HUB BOLT
REAR AXLE HUB BOLT
REMOVAL
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
SST
Turn
Hold
F047468E01
AH
1.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
2.
REMOVE REAR BRAKE DRUM SUB-ASSEMBLY
HINT:
Put matchmarks on the brake drum and hub.
3.
REMOVE REAR AXLE HUB BOLT LH
(a) Temporarily install 2 nuts to any 2 hub bolts, except
hub bolt that you will replace.
(b) Using SST and a screwdriver or equivalent to hold
the front axle, remove the hub bolt that needs to be
replaced.
SST 09628-10011
AXLE – REAR AXLE HUB BOLT
AH–9
INSTALLATION
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
INSTALL REAR AXLE HUB BOLT LH
(a) Insert a new hub bolt into the bolt hole. Set a plate
washer and nut on the hub bolt end.
(b) Using a screwdriver or equivalent to hold the front
axle, install the hub bolt by tightening the nut. Then
remove the nut and plate washer.
(c) Remove the 2 temporary nuts.
HINT:
A plate washer of 5 mm (0.20 in.) or more in
thickness is preferable.
Plate Washer
2.
INSTALL REAR BRAKE DRUM SUB-ASSEMBLY
HINT:
Align the matchmarks of the brake drum and axle hub
before installing them.
3.
INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 103 N*m (1,050 kgf*cm, 76 ft.*lbf)
Turn
Hold
A125167E02
AH
AH–9
AXLE – REAR AXLE HUB AND BEARING
REAR AXLE HUB AND BEARING
SUSPENSION & AXLE
AXLE
COMPONENTS
SKID CONTROL SENSOR WIRE
61 (622, 45)
REAR AXLE LH HUB BOLT
×5
REAR AXLE HUB AND
BEARING ASSEMBLY LH
61 (622, 45)
AH
REAR BRAKE DRUM SUB-ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B133192E01
AH–10
AXLE – REAR AXLE HUB AND BEARING
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT REAR AXLE HUB BEARING LOOSENESS
(a) Remove the rear wheel.
(b) Remove the rear brake drum.
HINT:
Put matchmarks on the rear brake drum and hub
bolt.
(c) Using a dial indicator, check for looseness at the
center of the axle hub.
Maximum looseness:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
If the looseness exceeds the maximum, replace the
axle hub.
2.
INSPECT REAR AXLE HUB BEARING RUNOUT
(a) Using a dial indicator, check for runout of the axle
hub.
Maximum runout:
0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
If the runout exceeds the maximum, replace the
axle hub.
(b) Install the rear brake drum.
HINT:
Align the matchmarks of the rear brake drum and
hub bolt before installing them.
(c) Install the rear wheel.
Torque: 103 N*m (1,050 kgf*cm, 76 ft.*lbf)
F046836E01
F046837E01
AH
AXLE – REAR AXLE HUB AND BEARING
AH–11
REMOVAL
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
2.
REMOVE REAR BRAKE DRUM SUB-ASSEMBLY
3.
DISCONNECT SKID CONTROL SENSOR
CONNECTOR
NOTICE:
Be careful that foreign matter does not attach to the
inside of the skid control sensor connector and on
the installation portion.
4.
REMOVE REAR AXLE HUB AND BEARING
ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and then remove the axle hub
and bearing.
C066800E01
AH
AH–12
AXLE – REAR AXLE HUB AND BEARING
INSTALLATION
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
AH
1.
INSTALL REAR AXLE HUB AND BEARING
ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the axle hub and bearing LH on the axle
beam with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 61 N*m (622 kgf*cm, 45 ft.*lbf)
2.
CONNECT SKID CONTROL SENSOR CONNECTOR
3.
INSPECT REAR AXLE HUB BEARING LOOSENESS
(See page AH-10)
4.
INSPECT REAR AXLE HUB BEARING RUNOUT (See
page AH-10)
5.
INSTALL REAR BRAKE DRUM SUB-ASSEMBLY
6.
INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 103 N*m (1,050 kgf*cm, 76 ft.*lbf)
7.
INSPECT REAR WHEEL ALIGNMENT (See page SP10)
8.
CHECK ABS SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–1
AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
NOTICE:
When disconnecting the cable from the negative (-)
battery terminal, initialize the following systems after the
cable is reconnected.
System name
See procedure
Power Window Control System
IN-32
AV
AV–2
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
FRONT SIDE SPEAKER
(FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER)
SPIRAL CABLE
STEERING PAD SWITCH
FRONT CENTER SPEAKER (FRONT
STEREO COMPONENT SPEAKER)*
MULTI-DISPLAY
FRONT SIDE SPEAKER
(FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER)
GATEWAY ECU
AV
FRONT SIDE SPEAKER
(FRONT NO. 1 SPEAKER)
FRONT SIDE SPEAKER
(FRONT NO. 1 SPEAKER)
DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
- ACC FUSE
- AM1 FUSE
- ACC-B FUSE
RADIO RECEIVER
*: for 9 Speaker System
E126612E01
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
ANTENNA AMPLIFIER
AV–3
REAR SIDE SPEAKER
(REAR NO. 2 SPEAKER)*
ANTENNA POLE
AV
REAR SIDE SPEAKER
(REAR NO. 2 SPEAKER)*
REAR SIDE SPEAKER
(REAR NO. 1 SPEAKER)
REAR SIDE SPEAKER
(REAR NO. 1 SPEAKER)
STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER
*: for 9 Speaker System
E126613E01
AV–4
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
for 9 Speaker System
Steering Pad Switch
Microphone
Combination Meter
Antenna
Speed Signal
Spiral Cable
Switch Signal
AV
Stereo Component
Amplifier
Radio Receiver
Multi-display
(Slave Unit)
Sound Signal
(Master Unit)
(Slave Unit)
Speakers
Sound Signal
Sound Signal
Stereo Jack
Adapter
: AVC-LAN
E107236E01
AV–5
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
for 6 Speaker System
Steering Pad Switch
Microphone
Combination Meter
Antenna
Speed Signal
Spiral Cable
Switch Signal
Multi-display
Radio Receiver
(Master Unit)
AV
(Slave Unit)
Sound Signal
Speakers
Stereo Jack Adapter
Sound Signal
Sound Signal
: AVC-LAN
E107237E01
AV–6
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
DISC PLAYER OUTLINE
(a) A CD player uses a laser pickup to read digital
signals recorded on CDs. By converting the digital
signals to analog, music and other content can be
played.
CAUTION:
Do not look directly at the laser pickup because
the CD player uses an invisible laser beam. Be
sure to operate the player only as instructed.
NOTICE:
• Do not disassemble any part of the CD player.
• Do not apply oil to the CD player.
• Do not insert anything but a CD into the CD
player.
(b) Usable discs
(1) CD player
AV
E119759
(c) Precautions for handling disc
NOTICE:
• Copy-controlled CDs cannot be used.
• Some CD-Rs and CD-RWs are not playable as
a result of: 1) the type of recording method
used, 2) the type of disc, 3) scratches, 4)
contamination, or 5) the disc being in the
vehicle for an extended amount of time,
leading to deterioration.
• CD-Rs and CD-RWs that have not been
finalized cannot be played.
• PAL or SECAM color television standard
discs cannot be played. Only NTSC discs can
be played.
• Dual layered discs that mate DVD recorded
material on one side with CD digital audio
material on the other cannot be played.
• When handling a disc, be careful not to put
fingerprints, stains or scratches on the disc.
• When holding a disc, pinch the center hole
and edge of the disc with your fingers. Face
the printed side upward.
• If a disc is ejected by pressing the eject
button and left partially ejected for an
extended period of time, the disc may
become deformed and unusable.
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–7
• A disc may not be able to be ejected or the
player may become damaged if: 1)
cellophane tape, stickers, CD-R labels or
rental CD labels are attached; or 2) residue
from removed tape, stickers or labels remain.
• Avoid direct sunlight when storing discs as
they may become deformed and unusable.
• Do not use uniquely-shaped discs as they
may damage the player.
• Do not use discs where part of the recording
surface is transparent or translucent. If used,
the disc may become unable to be inserted,
ejected and played normally.
HINT:
• Just as condensation fogs the vehicle's windows
during wet or cold weather, condensation may
also form inside the player. If condensation
forms, CD skipping or playback stoppage may
occur. Ventilate or dehumidify the vehicle for a
while before using the player.
• If the player vibrates severely due to driving on a
rough road, the CD may skip.
(d) Cleaning
NOTICE:
Do not use lens cleaner when cleaning the
player, as it may damage the player's pickup
part.
I100151
2.
(1) To clean dirty discs, use a dry, soft cloth such as
those used for glasses with plastic lenses.
Lightly wipe radially from the center of the disc.
NOTICE:
• Pressing the disc roughly with your hand
or scrubbing with a hard cloth may
scratch the disc surface.
• Using record spray, anti-static agents,
alcohol, benzene, thinner or other
solvents, and chemical cloths on a disc
will damage the disc and may make the
disc unusable.
MP3/WMA OUTLINE
HINT:
Some vehicle's audio and visual systems do not support
the WMA format.
(a) Playable MP3 file standards
Compatible standard
MP3 (MPEG1 LAYER3, MPEG2 LSF LAYER3)
Compatible sampling frequency
•
•
MPEG1 LAYER3: 32, 44.1, 48 (kHz)
MPEG2 LSF LAYER3: 16, 22.05, 24 (kHz)
•
MPEG1 LAYER3: 64, 80, 96, 112, 128, 160, 192, 224, 256, 320
(kbps)
MPEG2 LSF LAYER3: 64, 80, 96, 112, 128, 144, 160 (kbps)
Compatible with VBR
Compatible bit rate
Compatible channel mode
•
•
Stereo, joint stereo, dual channel, monaural
AV
AV–8
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
(b) Playable WMA file standards
Compatible standard
WMA Ver. 7, 8, and 9
Compatible sampling frequency
32, 44.1, 48 (kHz)
Compatible bit rate
•
•
•
Ver. 7, 8: CBR48, 64, 80, 96, 128, 160, 192 (kbps)
Ver. 9: CBR48, 64, 80, 96, 128, 160, 192, 256, 320 (kbps)
Compatible with playback of channel 2 only
(c) ID3 tag and WMA tag
(1) Additional textual information called ID3 tags
can be input to MP3 files. Information such as
song titles and artist names can be stored.
HINT:
This player is compatible with the ID3 tags of ID3
Ver. 1.0 and 1.1, and ID3 Ver. 2.2 and 2.3.
(Number of characters complies with ID3 Ver.
1.0 and 1.1.)
(2) Additional textual information called WMA tags
can be input to WMA files. Information such as
song titles and artist names can be stored.
(d) Usable media
(1) Only CD-ROMs, CD-Rs (CD-Recordable), and
CD-RWs (CD-ReWritable) can be used to play
MP3/WMA files.
NOTICE:
• CD-Rs and CD-RWs are more easily
affected by a hot and humid environment
than discs used for normal audio CDs. For
this reason, some CD-Rs and CD-RWs
may not be playable.
• If there are fingerprints or scratches on
the disc, the disc may not be playable or
the CD may skip.
• Some CD-Rs and CD-RWs deteriorate if
they are left in the cabin for a long time.
• Keep CD-Rs and CD-RWs in a storage
case that is non-transparent.
(e) Usable media format
(1) Usable media format
AV
Disc format
CD-ROM Mode 1, CD-ROM XA Mode 2 Form1
File format
ISO9660 Level 1 and Level 2 (Joliet, Romeo)
HINT:
• As for MP3/WMA files written in any format
other than those above, the contents of the
files may not be playable or the file names or
folder names may not be displayed correctly.
• This player is compatible with multi-session
discs and can play CD-Rs and CD-RWs on
which MP3/WMA files are added. However,
only the first session can be played.
• Discs whose first session includes both music
data and MP3 or WMA format data cannot be
played.
(2) Standards and restrictions
Maximum directory levels
8 levels
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–9
Maximum number of characters for a folder name/file name
32 characters
Maximum number of folders
192 (Including empty folders, root folders, and folders that do not
contain MP3/WMA files)
Maximum number of files in a disc
255 (Including non-MP3/WMA files)
(f)
3.
BLUETOOTH is a trademark
owned by Bluetooth SIG, Inc.
I101463E01
File names
(1) Only files with an extension of ".mp3" or ".wma"
can be recognized and played as MP3 or WMA
files.
(2) Save MP3 or WMA files with an extension of
".mp3" or ".wma".
NOTICE:
If saving non-MP3 or non-WMA files with an
extension of ".mp3" or ".wma", those files
are wrongly recognized as MP3 or WMA files
and played. A loud noise may occur and
damage to the speaker may result.
BLUETOOTH OUTLINE
(a) Bluetooth is a new wireless connection technology
that uses the 2.4 GHz frequency band. This makes
it possible to connect a cellular phone (Bluetooth
capable phone*) to the multi-display (Bluetooth
system is built-in), and use a handsfree function
with the cellular phone in a pocket or bag. As a
result, it is not necessary to use a connector for the
cellular phone.
HINT:
*: The communication performance of Bluetooth
may vary depending on the Bluetooth version,
obstructions or radio wave conditions between
communication devices, electromagnetic radiation,
communication device sensitivity, or antenna
capacity.
AV
AV–10
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Multi-display
(Built-in Bluetooth receiver antenna)
Cellular Tower
AV
Cellular Phone (Bluetooth Type)
I100033E09
4.
AVC-LAN DESCRIPTION
(a) What is AVC-LAN?
Example
Radio Receiver
(Resistor 60 to 80 Ω)
AVC-LAN
Stereo Component Amplifier
I100319E10
AVC-LAN, an abbreviation for "Audio Visual
Communication Local Area Network", is a united
standard developed by the manufacturers in
affiliation with Toyota Motor Corporation. This
standard pertains to audio and visual signals as well
as switch and communication signals.
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
5.
6.
AV–11
(b) Purpose:
Recently, car audio systems have rapidly developed
and the functions have vastly changed. The
conventional car audio system is being integrated
with multimedia interfaces similar to those in
navigation systems. At the same time, customers
are demanding higher quality from their audio
systems. This is an overview of the standardization
background. The specific purposes are as follows:
(1) To solve sound problems, etc. caused by using
components of different manufacturers through
signal standardization.
(2) To allow each manufacturer to concentrate on
developing products they do best. From this,
reasonably priced products can be produced.
HINT:
• If a short to +B or short to ground is detected
in the AVC-LAN circuit, communication is
interrupted and the audio system will stop
functioning.
• If an audio system is equipped with a
navigation system, the multi-display unit acts
as the master unit. If the navigation system is
not equipped, the audio head unit acts as the
master unit instead. If the radio and
navigation assembly is equipped, it is the
master unit.
• The radio receiver contains a resistor that is
necessary to enable communication on the
different AVC-LAN circuits.
• The car audio system with an AVC-LAN
circuit has a diagnostic function.
• Each component has a specified number (3digit) called a physical address. Each function
has a number (2-digit) called a logical
address.
COMMUNICATION SYSTEM OUTLINE
(a) Components of the audio system communicate with
each other via the AVC-LAN.
(b) The master component of the AVC-LAN is a radio
receiver with a 60 to 80 Ω resistor. This is essential
for communication.
(c) If a short circuit or open circuit occurs in the AVCLAN circuit, communication is interrupted and the
audio system will stop functioning.
DIAGNOSTIC FUNCTION OUTLINE
(a) The audio system has a diagnostic function (the
result is indicated on the master unit).
(b) A 3-digit hexadecimal component code (physical
address) is allocated to each component on the
AVC-LAN. Using this code, the component in the
diagnostic function can be displayed.
AV
AV–12
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
• Use these procedures to troubleshoot the audio and visual
system.
• *: Use the intelligent tester.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
INSPECT BATTERY VOLTAGE
Standard voltage:
11 to 14 V
If the voltage is below 11 V, recharge or replace the battery
before proceeding.
AV
NEXT
3
INSPECT COMMUNICATION FUNCTION OF MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
(BEAN)*
(a) Using the intelligent tester, check if the Multiplex
Communication System (MPX) is functioning normally.
Result
Result
Proceed to
MPX DTC is not output
A
MPX DTC is output
B
B
Go to MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION
SYSTEM
A
4
BASIC INSPECTION
(a) Turn the power switch ON (ACC).
(b) Check whether or not the radio receiver turns on.
Result
Result
Proceed to
Radio receiver turns on
A
Radio receiver does not turn on
B
B
A
Go to step 6
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
5
AV–13
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Check for DTCs and note any codes that are output (see
page AV-37).
(b) Delete the DTCs.
(c) Recheck by simulating the operation indicated by the
DTC.
HINT:
• If the system cannot enter the diagnosis mode,
inspect each AVC-LAN communication signal and
repair or replace the problem parts.
• Even if the malfunction symptom is not confirmed,
check the DTCs. This is because the system stores
past DTCs.
• Check and clear past DTCs. Then check for DTCs.
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC is output again
A
DTC is not output
B
B
Go to step 7
A
6
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
(a) Find the output code on the diagnostic trouble code chart
(see page AV-41).
NEXT
Go to step 9
7
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(a) Refer to the problem symptoms table (see page AV-29).
Result
Result
Proceed to
Fault is not listed in problem symptoms table
A
Fault is listed in problem symptoms table
B
B
Go to step 9
A
8
OVERALL ANALYSIS AND TROUBLESHOOTING
(a) Terminals of ECU (see page AV-31).
AV
AV–14
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
NEXT
9
REPAIR OR REPLACE
NEXT
10
NEXT
END
AV
CONFIRMATION TEST
AV–15
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
IDENTIFICATION OF NOISE SOURCE
1.
Frequency
300 kHz
30 kHz
Designation
RADIO DESCRIPTION
(a) Radio frequency band
(1) Radio broadcasts use the radio frequency bands
shown in the table below.
LF
MF
Modulation
HF
VHF
FM
Amplitude modulation
MF: Medium Frequency
300 MHz
30 MHz
AM
Radio Wave
LF: Low Frequency
30 MHz
HF: High Frequency
Frequency modulation
VHF: Very High Frequency
E108734E01
(b) Service area
(1) The service areas of AM and FM broadcasts are
vastly different. Sometimes an AM broadcast
can be received very clearly but an FM stereo
cannot. FM stereo has the smallest service area,
and is prone to pick up static and other types of
interference such as noise.
(c) Radio reception problems
HINT:
In addition to static, other problems such as
"phasing", "multipath", and "fade out" exist. These
problems are not caused by electrical noise, but by
the radio signal propagation method itself.
FM (Stereo)
FM (Monaural)
AM
E108735E01
Phasing
Ionosphere
I100011E02
(1) Phasing
AM broadcasts are susceptible to electrical
interference and another kind of interference
called phasing. Occurring only at night, phasing
is the interference created when a vehicle
receives 2 radio wave signals from the same
transmitter. One signal is reflected off the
ionosphere and the other signal is received
directly from the transmitter.
AV
AV–16
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
(2) Multipath
Multipath is a type of interference created when
a vehicle receives 2 radio wave signals from the
same transmitter. One signal is reflected off
buildings or mountains and the other signal is
received directly from the transmitter.
Multipath
I100012E02
(3) Fade out
Fade out is caused by objects (buildings,
mountains, and other such large obstacles) that
deflect away part of a signal, resulting in a
weaker signal when the object is between the
transmitter and vehicle. High frequency radio
waves, such as FM broadcasts, are easily
deflected by obstructions. Low frequency radio
waves, such as AM broadcasts, are much more
difficult to deflect.
(d) Noise problem
Technicians must have a clear understanding about
each customer's noise complaint. Use the following
table to diagnose noise problems.
Fade Out
I100013E02
AV
Radio Frequency
Noise Occurrence Condition
Presumable Cause
AM
Noise occurs in a specified area
Foreign noise
AM
Noise occurs when listening to an intermittent broadcast
Same program transmitted from multiple
towers can cause noise where the signals
overlap
AM
Noise occurs only at night
Music beats from a distant broadcast
Noise occurs while driving in a specified area
Multipath or phasing noise resulting from a
change in FM frequency
FM
HINT:
If the noise does not match the examples above, refer to the
descriptions about phasing and multipath.
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–17
DISPLAY CHECK MODE
HINT:
• This mode checks the color display on the multi-display.
• Illustrations may differ from the actual vehicle depending
on the device settings and options. Therefore, some
detailed areas may not be exactly the same as on the
actual vehicle.
1. ENTER DIAGNOSTIC MODE (see page AV-37)
2.
DISPLAY CHECK
(a) Select "Display Check" from the "Diagnosis MENU"
screen.
*
*: If this switch is gray, the Bluetooth TEL
Check inspection cannot be performed.
AV
E130103E01
3.
*
*: Depending on the type of audio system,
this switch may not be present.
E130108E01
COLOR BAR CHECK
(a) Select "Color Bar Check" from the "Display Check"
screen.
AV–18
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
(b) Select a color bar from the "Color Bar Check Mode"
screen.
(c) Check the display color.
HINT:
• The entire screen turns to the color or stripe
selected.
• Touch the display to the "Color Bar Check"
screen.
E120102
AV
4.
TOUCH SWITCH CHECK
(a) Select "Touch Switch Check" from the "Display
Check" screen.
*
*: Depending on the type of audio system,
this switch may not be present.
E130108E02
(b) Touch the display anywhere in the open area to
perform the check when the "Touch Switch Check"
screen is displayed.
HINT:
A "+" mark is displayed where the display is
touched.
E120103
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
5.
AV–19
PANEL SWITCH CHECK
(a) Select "Panel Switch Check" from the "Display
Check" screen.
*
*: Depending on the type of audio system,
this switch may not be present.
E130108E03
(b) Operate each switch and check that the switch
name and condition are correctly displayed.
*
AV
E126438E01
Display
Contents
•
•
Pressed switch name/*
6.
*
*: Depending on the type of audio system,
this switch may not be present.
E130108E04
Name of the pressed switch is displayed.
If more than one switch is pressed, "MULTIPLE" is displayed.
VEHICLE SIGNAL CHECK
(a) Select "Vehicle Signal Check" from the "Display
Check" screen.
AV–20
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
(b) When the "Vehicle Signal Check Mode" screen is
displayed, check all the vehicle signal conditions.
HINT:
• Only conditions having inputs are displayed.
• This screen is updated once per second when
input signals to the vehicle are changed.
• For details of this function, refer to DIAGNOSIS
DISPLAY DETAILED DESCRIPTION (see page
AV-22).
I038223
7.
MIC & VOICE RECOGNITION CHECK
(a) Select "Mic & Voice Recognition Check" on the
"Display Check" screen to display the
"MICROPHONE & VOICE RECOGNITION CHECK"
screen.
*
AV
*: Depending on the type of audio system,
this switch may not be present.
E130108E05
Microphone Input Level Meter
Recording
Switch
Stop
Switch
Recording
Play
Switch Indicator
E125811E01
(b) When a voice is input into the microphone, check
that the microphone input level meter changes
according to the input voice.
(c) Push the recording switch and perform voice
recording.
(d) Check that the recording indicator remains on while
recording and that the recorded voice is played
normally.
HINT:
For details of this function, refer to DIAGNOSIS
DISPLAY DETAILED DESCRIPTION (see page AV22).
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–21
BLUETOOTH TEL CHECK MODE
HINT:
Illustrations may differ from the actual vehicle depending on
the device settings and options. Therefore, some detailed
area may not be exactly the same as on the actual vehicle.
1. ENTER DIAGNOSTIC MODE (see page AV-37)
2.
BLUETOOTH TEL CHECK
(a) Select "Bluetooth TEL Check" from the "Diagnosis
MENU" screen.
If this switch is gray, the Bluetooth
TEL Check inspection cannot be
performed.
AV
E130112E01
3.
BLUETOOTH CHECK
(a) Select "Bluetooth Check" from the "Bluetooth
Handsfree Check Menu" screen.
E120063
(b) Select "Serial Communication Log" from the
"Bluetooth Check Menu" screen.
E120064
AV–22
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
(1) The communication log data in the multi-display
is displayed on this screen.
HINT:
The displayed data can be used as a reference.
E120065
(c) Select "Software Version" from the "Bluetooth
Check Menu" screen.
E120066
AV
(1) Check the software version of the Bluetooth
module.
*1
*2
*3
*4
E120067E02
Screen description:
Display
Contents
General Version/*1
•
•
Overall software version of Bluetooth module
If any of the API version, upper stack version, and low stack
version is updated, the general version is upgraded.
API Version/*2
API software version is displayed.
Upper Stack Version/*3
Upper Stack version is displayed.
Lower Stack Version/*4
Lower Stack version is displayed.
HINT:
This function is controlled by the multi-display.
4.
E120068
HANDSFREE VOICE QUALITY SET
(a) Select "Handsfree Voice Quality Set" from the
"Bluetooth Handsfree Check Menu" screen.
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–23
(b) Check the handsfree voice level.
*1
*2
E120069E01
Screen description:
Display
Contents
Received voice level adjustment/*1
Setting possible for the voice level received from Bluetooth compatible
phones.
Sent voice level adjustment/*2
Setting possible for the voice sent to Bluetooth compatible phones.
HINT:
This function is controlled by the multi-display.
NOTICE:
"Voice Quality Type" should not be changed.
AV
AV–24
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DIAGNOSIS DISPLAY DETAILED
DESCRIPTION
HINT:
• This section contains a detailed description of displays
within diagnostic mode.
• Illustrations may differ from the actual vehicle depending
on the device settings and options. Therefore, some
detailed areas may not be exactly the same as on the
actual vehicle.
1. SYSTEM CHECK
(a) System Check Mode Screen
AV
*1
*2
*3
*1
*4
*2
I100055E08
(1) Device Names and Hardware Address/*1
HINT:
• Registered device names are displayed.
• If a device name is unknown to the system,
its physical address is shown instead.
Address No.
Name
Address No.
Name
110
EMV
120
AVX
128
1DIN TV
140
AVN
144
G-BOOK
178
NAVI
17C
MONET
190
AUDIO H/U
1AC
CAMERA-C
1B0
Rr-TV
1C0
Rr-CONT
19D
BT-HF
1C4
PANEL
1C6
G/W
1C8
FM-M-LCD
1D8
CONT-SW
1EC
Body
118
EMVN
1F1
XM
1F2
SIRIUS
230
TV-TUNER
240
CD-CH2
250
DVD-CH
280
CAMERA
360
CD-CH1
3A0
MD-CH
AV–25
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Address No.
Name
Address No.
Name
17D
TEL
440
DSP-AMP
530
ETC
1F6
RSE
1A0
DVD-P
1D6
CLOCK
238
DTV
480
AMP
(2) Check Result/*2
HINT:
Result codes for all devices are displayed.
Result
Meaning
Action
OK
Device did not respond with DTC (excluding
communication DTCs from AVC-LAN).
-
EXCH
Device responds with "replace" type DTC.
Look up DTC in "Unit Check Mode" and
replace device.
CHEK
Device responds with "check" type DTC.
Look up DTC in "Unit Check Mode".
NCON
Device was previously present, but does not
respond in diagnostic mode.
1. Check power supply wire harness of
device.
2. Check AVC-LAN of device.
Old
Device responds with "old" type DTC.
Look up DTC in "Unit Check Mode".
NRES
Device responds in diagnostic mode, but
gives no DTC information.
1. Check power supply wire harness of
device.
2. Check AVC-LAN of device.
(3) Code Clear/*3
• Present DTCs are cleared.
• Press the "Code CLR" switch for 3 seconds.
(4) Memory Clear/*4
• Present and past DTCs and registered
connected device names are cleared.
• Press the "Memory CLR" switch for 3
seconds.
(b) Diagnosis MENU Screen
*
*: If this switch is gray, the Bluetooth TEL Check inspection cannot be performed.
E120070E02
AV
AV–26
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
HINT:
Each item is grayed out or not displayed based on
the device settings.
(c) Unit Check Mode Screen
*1
*6
*5
AV
*2
*3
*4
*7
E120071E02
Screen description:
Display
Contents
Device name/*1
Target device
Segment/*2
Target device logical address
DTC/*3
DTC (Diagnostic Trouble Code)
Timestamp/*4
Time and date of past DTCs are displayed (Year is displayed in 2-digit
format).
Present Code/*5
DTCs output at service check are displayed.
Past Code/*6
Diagnostic memory results and recorded DTCs are displayed.
Diagnosis Clear Switch/*7
Pushing this switch for 3 seconds clears diagnostic memory data of
target device (both response to diagnostic system check result and
displayed data are cleared).
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–27
(d) LAN Monitor (Original) Screen
*1
I100058E04
(1) Check Result/*1
HINT:
The check results of all the devices are
displayed.
Result
Meaning
Action
No Err (OK)
There are no communication DTCs.
-
CHEK
Device responds with "check" type DTC.
Look up DTC in "Unit Check Mode".
NCON
Device was previously present, but does not
respond in diagnostic mode.
1. Check power supply wire harness of
device.
2. Check AVC-LAN of device.
Old
Device responds with "old" type DTC.
Look up DTC in "Unit Check Mode".
NRES
Device responds in diagnostic mode, but
gives no DTC information.
1. Check power supply wire harness of
device.
2. Check AVC-LAN of device.
AV
AV–28
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
(e) LAN Monitor (Individual) Screen
*1
*2
*3
*4
*5
*7
*6
AV
E120072E01
Screen description:
Display
Contents
Device name/*1
Target device
Segment/*2
Target logical address
DTC/*3
DTC (Diagnostic Trouble Code)
Sub-code (device address)/*4
Physical address stored with DTC (If there is no address, nothing is
displayed).
Connection check No./*5
Connection check number stored with DTC
DTC occurrence/*6
Number of times same DTC has been recorded
Diagnosis Clear Switch/*7
Pushing this switch for 3 seconds clears diagnostic memory data of
target device (both response to diagnostic system check result and
displayed data are cleared).
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
2.
AV–29
DISPLAY CHECK
(a) Vehicle Signal Check Mode Screen
I100060
Screen description:
Name
Contents
Battery
Battery voltage is displayed.
PKB
Parking brake ON / OFF state is displayed.
REV
Reverse signal ON / OFF state is displayed.
IG
Power switch ON / OFF state is displayed.
ADIM/TCAN
Brightness state DIM (with) / BRIGHT (without) is displayed.
TAIL
TAIL signal (Light control switch) ON / OFF state is displayed.
SPEED
Vehicle speed is displayed in km/h.
HINT:
• Only items sending a vehicle signal will be
displayed.
• This screen is updated once per second when
input signals to the vehicle are changed.
AV
AV–30
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
(b) Microphone & Voice Recognition Check Screen
*1
*2
*3
*4
AV
*5
E125091E01
HINT:
Depending on the type of audio system, this menu
may not be present.
Screen description:
Name
Contents
Microphone input level meter/*1
Monitors microphone input level every 100 ms and displays results in
8 different levels.
Recording switch/*2
Starts recording.
Stop switch/*3
Stops recording.
Play switch/*4
Plays recorded voice.
Recording indicator/*5
Comes on while recording.
HINT:
• The microphone input function is on at all times
when this screen is displayed.
• While recording or playing, the switches other
than the stop switch cannot be pushed.
• When no voice is recorded, the play switch
cannot be pushed.
• Recording will stop after 5 seconds or by pushing
the stop switch.
AV–31
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
• Use the table below to help determine the cause of the
problem symptom. The potential causes of the symptoms
are listed in order of probability in the "Suspected area"
column of the table. Check each symptom by checking the
suspected areas in the order they are listed. Replace parts
as necessary.
• Inspect the fuses and relays related to this system before
inspecting the suspected areas below.
Audio function
Symptom
Pressing power switch does not turn on system.
Suspected area
See page
1. Proceed to "Pressing Power Switch does not Turn on
System"
AV-96
2. Radio receiver power source circuit
AV-171
3. Multi-display power source circuit
AV-175
4. AVC-LAN circuit
AV-148
5. Radio receiver
AV-31
6. Multi-display
AV-31
1. Steering pad switch circuit
AV-119
2. AVC-LAN circuit
AV-148
3. Radio receiver
AV-31
1. AVC-LAN circuit
AV-148
2. Radio receiver power source circuit
AV-171
3. Multi-display power source circuit
AV-175
4. Proceed to "No Sound can be Heard from Speakers"
AV-97
5. Stereo component amplifier power source circuit
AV-173
6. Proceed to "Sound Signal Circuit between Radio Receiver
and Stereo Component Amplifier"
AV-142
7. Speaker circuit
AV-130
8. Proceed to "Mute Signal Circuit between Radio Receiver
and Stereo Component Amplifier"
AV-146
9. Stereo component amplifier
AV-31
10. Radio receiver
AV-31
11. Multi-display
AV-31
1. Proceed to "Poor Sound Quality in All Models (Low
Volume)"
AV-107
2. Speaker circuit
AV-130
3. Proceed to !Sound Signal Circuit between Radio Receiver
and Stereo Component Amplifier"
AV-142
4. Proceed to "Mute Signal Circuit between Radio Receiver
and Stereo Component Amplifier"
AV-146
Auto sound levelizer does not function (9 speaker
system).
Proceed to "Vehicle Speed Signal Circuit between Stereo
Component Amplifier and Combination Meter"
AV-150
Auto sound levelizer does not function (6 speaker
system).
Proceed to "Vehicle Speed Signal Circuit between Radio
Receiver and Combination Meter"
AV-116
1. Radio receiver power source circuit
AV-171
2. Proceed to "Sound Signal Circuit between Radio Receiver
and Stereo Jack Adapter"
AV-144
3. Stereo jack adapter
-
4. Radio receiver
AV-31
Panel switch does not function.
No sound can be heard from speakers (audio is mute).
Sound quality is bad in all modes (Volume is too low).
External device sound cannot be heard or sound
quality is bad (Stereo jack is used).
AV
AV–32
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Symptom
Abnormal noise occurs.
Radio broadcast cannot be received or poor reception.
CD cannot be inserted/played or CD is ejected right
after insertion.
CD cannot be ejected.
Suspected area
See page
1. Proceed to "Noise occurs"
AV-94
2. Stereo component amplifier
AV-31
3. Radio receiver
AV-31
Proceed to "Radio Broadcast cannot be Received or Poor
Reception"
AV-104
1. Radio receiver power source circuit
AV-171
2. Proceed to "CD cannot be Inserted/Played or CD is Ejected
Right After Insertion"
AV-100
1. Radio receiver power source circuit
AV-171
2. Proceed to "CD cannot be Ejected"
AV-99
Sound quality is bad only when CD is played.
Proceed to "Sound Quality is Bad Only when CD is Played
(Volume is Too Low)"
AV-98
CD sounds skips.
Proceed to "CD Sound Skips"
AV-102
Radio receiver or multi-display cannot be illuminated at
night.
Illumination circuit
AV-123
Steering pad switch function
Symptom
AV
Suspected area
See page
Audio system cannot be operated with steering pad
switch.
1. Steering pad switch circuit
AV-119
2. Radio receiver
AV-31
Steering pad switch cannot be illuminated at night.
Illumination circuit
AV-123
Cellular phone registration failure, phone directory
transfer failure.
Proceed to "Cellular Phone Registration Failure, Phone
Directory Transfer Failure"
AV-108
1. Proceed to Cellular Phone cannot Send / Receive
AV-110
2. Steering pad switch circuit
AV-119
3. Multi-display
AV-31
Proceed to "Cannot call in a Certain Place"
AV-112
1. Proceed to "The Other Caller's Voice cannot be Heard, is
too Quiet, or Distorted"
AV-113
2. Multi-display
AV-31
1. Proceed to "The Other Caller cannot Hear Your Voice, or
Your Voice is too Quiet or Distorted"
AV-114
2. Microphone circuit between overhead J/B and multi-display
AV-153
3. Microphone
-
4. Microphone amplifier
-
5. Multi-display
AV-31
Cellular phone cannot send / receive.
Cannot call in a certain place.
The other caller's voice cannot be heard, is too quiet,
or distorted.
The other caller cannot hear your voice, or your voice
is too quiet or distorted.
AV–33
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
CHECK MULTI-DISPLAY (for 3 Connector Type)
M13
M14
M15
I101059E03
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
ILL+ (M13-1) - GND1
(M13-3)
G - BR
Illumination (rheostat)
signal
Power switch OFF
Below 1 V
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
GND1 (M13-3) - Body
ground
BR - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
TX1+ (M13-4) - GND1
(M13-3)
B - BR
AVC-LAN communication
signal
Power switch ON (IG)
2 to 3 V
TX1- (M13-5) - GND1
(M13-3)
W - BR
AVC-LAN communication
signal
Power switch ON (IG)
2 to 3 V
TC (M13-7) - GND1 (M133)
P - BR
Diagnosis ON signal
Power switch OFF
Below 1 V
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
IG (M13-10) - GND1
(M13-3)
B - BR
Power switch IG
Power switch OFF
Below 1 V
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
ACC (M13-11) - GND1
(M13-3)
GR - BR
Power switch ACC
Power switch OFF
Below 1 V
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
B1 (M13-12) - GND1
(M13-3)
Y - BR
Battery
Always
10 to 14 V
ILL- (M13-2) - GND1
(M13-3)
W-B - BR
Illumination (rheostat)
signal
Power switch OFF
Below 1 V
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
DR (M13-17) - GND1
(M13-3)
B - BR
Dimmer signal
Light control switch OFF
Below 1 V
Light control switch TAIL
or HEAD
10 to 14 V
TX2+ (M13-18) - GND1
(M13-3)
P - BR
AVC-LAN communication
signal
Power switch ON (IG)
2 to 3 V
TX2- (M13-19) - GND1
(M13-3)
W - BR
AVC-LAN communication
signal
Power switch ON (IG)
2 to 3 V
SPD (M13-25) - GND1
(M13-3)
V - BR
Speed signal from
combination meter
See "vehicle signal check
mode"
-
AV
AV–34
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
2.
M16
M15
CHECK MULTI-DISPLAY (for 4 Connector Type)
M13
M14
E123948E04
AV
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
ILL+ (M13-12) - GND
(M13-1)
G - BR
Illumination (rheostat)
signal
Power switch OFF
Below 1 V
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
GND (M13-1) - Body
ground
BR - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
TX1+ (M13-4) - GND
(M13-1)
B - BR
AVC-LAN communication
signal
Power switch ON (IG)
2 to 3 V
TX1- (M13-5) - GND
(M13-1)
W - BR
AVC-LAN communication
signal
Power switch ON (IG)
2 to 3 V
TC (M13-7) - GND (M131)
P - BR
Diagnosis ON signal
Power switch OFF
Below 1 V
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
IG (M13-10) - GND (M131)
B - BR
Power switch OFF
Below 1 V
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
Power switch OFF
Below 1 V
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
Power switch IG
ACC (M13-2) - GND (M13- GR - BR
1)
Power switch ACC
+B1 (M13-3) - GND (M131)
Y - BR
Battery
Always
10 to 14 V
ILL- (M13-11) - GND
(M13-1)
W-B - BR
Illumination (rheostat)
signal
Power switch OFF
Below 1 V
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
DR (M13-17) - GND (M131)
B - BR
Dimmer signal
Light control switch OFF
Below 1 V
Light control switch TAIL
or HEAD
10 to 14 V
TX2+ (M13-18) - GND
(M13-1)
P - BR
AVC-LAN communication
signal
Power switch ON (IG)
2 to 3 V
TX2- (M13-19) - GND
(M13-1)
W - BR
AVC-LAN communication
signal
Power switch ON (IG)
2 to 3 V
SPD (M13-20) - GND
(M13-1)
V - BR
Speed signal from
combination meter
See "vehicle signal check
mode"
-
MIN+ (M14-2) - Body
ground
G - Body ground
Microphone voice signal
See "Microphone & Voice
Recognition Check" mode
-
MIN- (M14-3) - Body
ground
R - Body ground
Microphone voice signal
See "Microphone & Voice
Recognition Check" mode
-
MACC (M14-4) - Body
ground
BR - Body ground
Microphone amplifier
power supply
Power switch ON (IG)
5V
AV–35
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
3.
R3
CHECK RADIO RECEIVER (for 6 Speaker System)
R5
R4
E110945E03
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
RR+ (R4-1) - GND (R3-7)
R - BR
Sound signal (Rear Right)
Audio system is sounding
-
RL+ (R4-2) - GND (R3-7)
B - BR
Sound signal (Rear Left)
Audio system is sounding
-
RR- (R4-3) - GND (R3-7)
W - BR
Sound signal (Rear Right)
Audio system is sounding
-
RL- (R4-6) - GND (R3-7)
Y - BR
Sound signal (Rear Left)
Audio system is sounding
-
FR+ (R3-1) - GND (R3-7)
LG - BR
Sound signal (Front Right)
Audio system is sounding
-
FL+ (R3-2) - GND (R3-7)
P - BR
Sound signal (Front Left)
Audio system is sounding
-
Turn power switch OFF
Below 1 V
ACC (R3-3) - GND (R3-7)
GR - BR
Accessory (ON)
Turn power switch ON
(ACC)
10 to 14 V
+B (R3-4) - GND (R3-7)
SB - BR
Battery
Always
10 to 14 V
FR- (R3-5) - GND (R3-7)
L - BR
Sound signal (Front Right)
Audio system is sounding
-
FL- (R3-6) - GND (R3-7)
V - BR
Sound signal (Front Left)
Audio system is sounding
-
GND (R3-7) - Body ground
BR - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
ANT+ (R3-8) - GND (R37)
O - BR
Power source of antenna
Radio switch ON
10 to 14 V
Turn light control switch
OFF
Below 1 V
Turn light control switch
TAIL or HEAD (Light
intensity is max.)
10 to 14 V
ILL+ (R3-10) - GND (R3-7)
G - BR
Illumination signal
TX1+ (R5-9) - GND (R3-7)
P - BR
AVC-LAN communication
signal
Turn power switch ON
(ACC)
2 to 3 V
TX1- (R5-10) - GND (R37)
W - BR
AVC-LAN communication
signal
Turn power switch ON
(ACC)
2 to 3 V
SWG (R5-6) - GND (R3-7)
R - BR
Steering pad switch
ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
Steering pad switch not
operated
4 V or more
SW1 (R5-7) - GND (R3-7)
SW2 (R5-8) - GND (R3-7)
ILL- (R4-5) - GND (R3-7)
B - BR
W - BR
W-B - BR
Steering pad switch signal
Steering pad switch signal
Illumination signal
SEEK+ switch pushed
Approx. 0.5 V
SEEK- switch pushed
Approx. 0.9 V
VOL+ switch pushed
Approx. 2.0 V
VOL- switch pushed
Approx. 3.4 V
Steering pad switch not
operated
4 V or more
MODE switch pushed
Below 2.5 V
Turn light control switch
OFF
Below 1 V
Turn light control switch
TAIL or HEAD (Light
intensity is max.)
10 to 14 V
AV
AV–36
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
4.
CHECK RADIO RECEIVER (for 9 Speaker System)
R6
R5
6
I040207E02
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
+B (R6-1) - GND (R6-20)
SB - BR
Battery
ILL+ (R6-2) - GND (R6-20) G - BR
AV
Illumination signal
Condition
Specified Condition
Always
10 to 14 V
Turn light control switch
OFF
Below 1 V
Turn light control switch
TAIL or HEAD (Light
intensity is max.)
10 to 14 V
MUTE (R6-7) - GND (R620)
Audio system is sounding
Above 3.5 V
W - BR
MUTE signal
Audio system is changing
mode
Below 1 V
R+ (R6-8) - GND (R6-20)
R - BR
Sound signal (Right)
Audio system is sounding
-
L+ (R6-9) - GND (R6-20)
W - BR
Sound signal (Left)
Audio system is sounding
-
SLD (R6-10) - Body
ground
Shielded - Body ground
Shield ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
ACC (R6-11) - GND (R620)
Turn power switch OFF
Below 1 V
GR - BR
Accessory
Turn power switch ON
(ACC)
10 to 14 V
ANT+ (R6-13) - GND (R620)
O - BR
Power source of antenna
Radio switch ON
10 to 14 V
R- (R6-18) - GND (R6-20)
G - BR
Sound signal (Right)
Audio system is sounding
-
L- (R6-19) - GND (R6-20)
B - BR
Sound signal (Left)
Audio system is sounding
-
GND (R6-20) - Body
ground
BR - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
TX+ (R6-5) - GND (R6-20)
P - BR
AVC-LAN communication
signal
Turn power switch ON
(ACC)
2 to 3 V
TX- (R6-15) - GND (R620)
O - BR
AVC-LAN communication
signal
Turn power switch ON
(ACC)
2 to 3 V
SWG (R5-6) - GND (R620)
R - BR
Steering pad switch
ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
Steering pad switch not
operated
4 V or more
SEEK+ switch pushed
Approx. 0.5 V
SEEK- switch pushed
Approx. 0.9 V
SW1 (R5-7) - GND (R620)
B - BR
ILL- (R6-12) - GND (R620)
W-B - BR
SW2 (R5-8) - GND (R620)
W - BR
Steering pad switch signal
Illumination signal
Steering pad switch signal
VOL+ switch pushed
Approx. 2.0 V
VOL- switch pushed
Approx. 3.4 V
Turn light control switch
OFF
Below 1 V
Turn light control switch
TAIL or HEAD (Light
intensity is max.)
10 to 14 V
Steering pad switch not
operated
4 V or more
MODE switch pushed
Below 2.5 V
AV–37
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
TX+ (R5-9) - GND (R6-20)
P - BR
AVC-LAN communication
signal
Turn power switch ON
(ACC)
2 to 3 V
TX- (R5-10) - GND (R620)
W - BR
AVC-LAN communication
signal
Turn power switch ON
(ACC)
2 to 3 V
ARI (R5-15) - GND (R620)
G - BR
Sound signal (Right)
External device is playing
(When stereo jack is used)
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
ASGN (R5-16) - GND (R620)
Shielded - Body ground
Shield ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
ALI (R5-17) - GND (R620)
R - BR
Sound signal (Left)
External device is playing
(When stereo jack is used)
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
AUXI (R5-19) - GND (R620)
W - BR
External device
connection detection
signal
External device is
connection
Below 1 Ω
5.
S29
CHECK STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER (for 9
Speaker System)
S15
S14
AV
E107188E02
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
+B (S14-1) - GND (S29-6)
SB - W-B
Battery
Always
10 to 14 V
CTR+ (S29-4) - GND
(S29-6)
R - W-B
Sound Signal (Center)
Audio system playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
RL+ (S14-3) - GND (S296)
B - W-B
Sound Signal (Left)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
RR+ (S14-10) - GND
(S29-6)
R - W-B
Sound signal (Right)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
FL+ (S14-8) - GND (S296)
P - W-B
Sound signal (Left)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
FR+ (S14-2) - GND (S296)
LG - W-B
Sound signal (Right)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
WFL+ (S29-2) - GND
(S29-6)
P - W-B
Sound signal (Left)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
WFR+ (S29-9) - GND
(S29-6)
LG - W-B
Sound signal (Right)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
+B2 (S14-5) - GND (S296)
SB - W-B
Battery
Always
10 to 14 V
CTR- (S29-10) - GND
(S29-6)
W - W-B
Sound signal (Center)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
RL- (S14-9) - GND (S296)
Y - W-B
Sound signal (Left)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
RR- (S14-4) - GND (S296)
W - W-B
Sound signal (Right)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
GND2 (S29-7) - Body
ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
GND (S29-6) - Body
ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
SPD (S15-11) - GND
(S29-6)
V - W-B
Speed signal from
combination meter
See "vehicle signal check
mode"
-
AV–38
Symbols (Terminal No.)
AV
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
FL- (S14-7) - GND (S29-6) V - W-B
Sound signal (Left)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
FR- (S14-6) - GND (S296)
Sound signal (Right)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
WFL- (S29-1) - GND (S29V - W-B
6)
Sound signal (Left)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
WFR- (S29-3) - GND
(S29-6)
L - W-B
Sound signal (Right)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
MUTE (S15-1) - GND
(S29-6)
Audio system is playing
Above 3.5 V
W - W-B
Mute signal
Audio system is changing
mode
Below 1 V
L- (S15-2) - GND (S29-6)
B - W-B
Sound signal (Left)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
L+ (S15-3) - GND (S29-6)
W - W-B
Sound signal (Left)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
R- (S15-4) - GND (S29-6)
G - W-B
Sound signal (Right)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
R+ (S15-5) - GND (S29-6)
R - W-B
Sound signal (Right)
Audio system is playing
A waveform synchronized
with sounds is output
TX- (S15-7) - GND (S296)
O - W-B
AVC-LAN communication
signal
Power switch ON (IG)
2 to 3 V
TX+ (S15-8) - GND (S296)
P - W-B
AVC-LAN communication
signal
Power switch ON (IG)
2 to 3 V
ACC (S15-12) - GND
(S29-6)
GR - W-B
Power switch ACC
Power switch OFF
Below 1 V
Power switch ON (ACC)
10 to 14 V
L - W-B
6.
CHECK NETWORK GATEWAY ECU
G1
E072244E06
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
GND (G1-24) - Body
ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
BATT (G1-10) - Body
ground
Y - Body ground
Battery power supply
Always
10 to 14 V
IG (G1-1) - Body ground
B - Body ground
Ignition power supply
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
ACC (G1-2) - Body ground
P - Body ground
ACC power supply
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
GTX+ (G1-6) - Body
ground
B - Body ground
AVC-LAN communication
signal
Power switch ON (ACC)
2 to 3 V
GTX- (G1-21) - Body
ground
W - Body ground
AVC-LAN communication
signal
Power switch ON (ACC)
2 to 3 V
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–39
DTC CHECK / CLEAR
1.
START DIAGNOSTIC MODE
HINT:
• The illustrations may differ depending on the device
settings (options, etc.). Therefore, some detailed
areas may not be exactly the same as on the actual
vehicle.
• After the power switch is turned ON (ACC), check that
the map is displayed before starting the diagnostic
mode. Otherwise, some items cannot be checked.
(a) There are 2 methods to start diagnostic mode. Start
the mode by using one of them.
(b) Method 1
(1) Start the hybrid system.
(2) While pressing and holding the "INFO" switch,
operate the light control switch OFF → TAIL →
OFF → TAIL → OFF → TAIL → OFF.
(3) The diagnostic mode starts and the "Service
Check" screen will be displayed. The service
inspection starts automatically and the result will
be displayed.
E107189
I102032
2.
(c) Method 2
(1) Start the hybrid system.
(2) Press the "Display" switch.
(3) On the display adjustment screen, touch the
corners of the screen in the following order:
upper left → lower left → upper left → lower left
→ upper left → lower left.
(4) The diagnostic mode starts and the "Service
Check" screen will be displayed. The service
inspection starts automatically and the result will
be displayed.
(d) Diagnosis MENU
Press the menu switch on the service check screen.
The diagnostic window will be displayed.
FINISH DIAGNOSTIC MODE
(a) Use one of the following 2 methods to finish the
diagnostic mode.
(1) Turn the power switch OFF.
(2) Press the "Display" switch for 3 seconds.
AV
AV–40
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
3.
SYSTEM CHECK MODE (DTC CHECK)
HINT:
The illustrations may differ depending on the device
settings (options, etc.). Therefore, some detailed areas
may not be exactly the same as on the actual vehicle.
(a) Start the diagnostic mode.
*
*: If this switch is gray, the Bluetooth TEL
Check inspection cannot be performed.
E130106E01
AV
(b) Read the service check result.
If all the devices report as "EXCH", "CHEK" or "Old",
touch the display to check the contents in the "Unit
Check Mode" screen and write them into the
customer problem analysis check sheet.
Diagnostic Code
Logical Address
E111052E02
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–41
HINT:
• If all the check results are "OK", go to the
communication DTC check.
• If a device name is not known, its physical
address is displayed.
• If "EXCH", "CHEK" and "Old" as well as "OK" are
shown, press the service switch to return to the
"System Check Mode". Then, check the "Unit
Check Mode" screen and fill them in on the
customer problem analysis check sheet.
Example
Diagnostic Code
Logical Address
I038207E08
(c) Read the communication diagnostic check result.
(1) Return to the "System Check Mode", and press
"LAN Mon" switch to enter the LAN monitor
window.
Example
E111053E01
AV
AV–42
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
4.
Diagnostic Code
Sub-code
Logical Address
(2) If the result is "CHEK" or "Old", touch this display
to check the contents on the "Unit Check Mode"
screen and write them into the customer
problem analysis check sheet.
HINT:
• If all check results are "No Err", the system
judges that no DTC exists.
• The sub-code (relevant device) will be
indicated by its physical address.
• If a check result is "CHEK", press the
"Service" switch to return to the "LAN
Monitor" screen. Then, check the individual
communication diagnostic screen for the next
device and fill out the result on the customer
problem analysis check sheet.
SERVICE CHECK MODE (DTC CLEAR/RECHECK)
HINT:
The illustrations may differ from the actual vehicle
depending on the device settings and options.
E126493E01
AV
(a) Clear DTC
(1) Press the "Code CLR" switch for 3 seconds.
E111072E01
(2) Check result is cleared.
(b) Recheck
(1) Press the "Recheck" switch.
E111073E02
(2) Confirm that all diagnostic codes are "OK" when
the check results are displayed.
If a code other than "OK" is displayed,
troubleshoot again.
E111074E01
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–43
(3) Press "LAN Mon" to switch to "LAN Monitor"
mode.
E111075E01
(4) Confirm that all diagnostic codes are "No Err".
If a code other than "No Err" is displayed,
troubleshoot again.
E111076E01
AV
AV–44
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
Communication diagnosis
DTC No.
01-21
Detection Item
Trouble Area
See page
ROM Error
Multi-display
AV-46
01-22
RAM Error
Multi-display
AV-46
01-D5
Absence of Registration Unit
1. Power source circuit of
component shown by sub-code
2. AVC-LAN circuit between multidisplay and component shown by
sub-code
3. Component shown by subcode
AV-47
01-D6
No Master
1. Multi-display power source
circuit
2. Power source circuit of
component which has stored this
code
3. AVC-LAN circuit between multidisplay and component which has
stored this code
4. Component which has stored
this code
5. Multi-display
AV-49
01-D7
Connection Check Error
1. Multi-display power source
circuit
2. Power source circuit of
component which has stored this
code
3. AVC-LAN circuit between multidisplay and component which has
stored this code
4. Component which has stored
this code
5. Multi-display
AV-49
01-D8
No Response for Connection
Check
1. Power source circuit of
component shown by sub-code
2. AVC-LAN circuit between multidisplay and component shown by
sub-code
3. Component shown by subcode
AV-47
01-D9
Last Mode Error
1. Power source circuit of
component shown by sub-code
2. AVC-LAN circuit between multidisplay and component shown by
sub-code
3. Component shown by subcode
AV-47
01-DA
No Response Against ON / OFF
Command
1. Power source circuit of
component shown by sub-code
2. AVC-LAN circuit between multidisplay and component shown by
sub-code
3. Component shown by subcode
AV-47
01-DB
Mode Status Error
1. Power source circuit of
component shown by sub-code
2. AVC-LAN circuit between multidisplay and component shown by
sub-code
3. Component shown by subcode
AV-47
AV
AV–45
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC No.
Trouble Area
See page
01-DC
Transmission Error
Detection Item
If same sub-code is recorded in
other components, check harness
for power supply and
communication system of all
components shown by sub-code
AV-53
01-DD
Master Reset
1. Multi-display power source
circuit
2. AVC-LAN circuit between multidisplay and component which has
stored this code
3. Multi-display
4. Component which has stored
this code
AV-56
01-DE
Slave Reset
1. Power source circuit of
component shown by sub-code
2. AVC-LAN circuit between multidisplay and component shown by
sub-code
3. Component shown by subcode
AV-47
01-DF
Master Error
1. Multi-display power source
circuit
2. AVC-LAN circuit between multidisplay and component which has
stored this code
3. Multi-display
4. Component which has stored
this code
AV-60
AV
01-E0
Registration Complete Indication
Error
-
AV-64
01-E1
Voice Processing Device ON
Error
1. Multi-display power source
circuit
2. AVC-LAN circuit between multidisplay and component which has
stored this code
3. Multi-display
4. Component which has stored
this code
AV-56
01-E2
ON / OFF Indication Parameter
Error
Multi-display
AV-65
01-E3
Registration Demand
Transmission
-
AV-64
01-E4
Multiple Frame Incomplete
-
AV-64
Bluetooth
DTC No.
57-47
Detection Item
Bluetooth Module Initialization
Failed
Trouble Area
-
See page
AV-66
Radio unit
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
See page
60-10
AM Tuner PLL does not Lock
Error
Radio receiver
AV-67
60-11
FM Tuner PLL does not Lock
Error
Radio receiver
AV-67
60-42
Tuner Power Source Error
Radio receiver
AV-68
60-43
AM Tuner Error
Radio receiver
AV-68
60-44
FM Tuner Error
Radio receiver
AV-68
60-50
Malfunction in Internal IC
Radio receiver
AV-68
AV–46
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
CD player
DTC No.
AV
Detection Item
Trouble Area
See page
62-10
CD Player Mechanical Error
Radio receiver
AV-69
62-11
CD Insertion and Eject Error
Radio receiver
AV-69
62-12
CD Reading Abnormal
Radio receiver
AV-69
62-40
No Disc
1. CD
2. Radio receiver
AV-70
62-41
Wrong Disc
1. CD
2. Radio receiver
AV-71
62-42
Disc cannot be Read
1. CD
2. Radio receiver
AV-71
62-43
CD-ROM Abnormal
1. CD
2. Radio receiver
1. CD
2. Radio receiver
AV-73
62-44
CD Abnormal
Radio receiver
AV-75
62-45
Eject Error
Radio receiver
AV-76
62-46
Scratched / Reversed Disc
1. CD
2. Radio receiver
AV-77
62-47
High Temperature
Radio receiver
AV-79
62-48
Excess Current
Radio receiver
AV-75
62-50
Tray Insertion / Ejection Error
Radio receiver
AV-75
62-51
Elevator Error
Radio receiver
AV-76
62-52
Clamp Error
Radio receiver
AV-76
62-78
DSP Error
Radio receiver
AV-80
62-7D
Disc cannot be Played
1. CD
2. Radio receiver
AV-81
62-7E
No Playable Files
1. CD
2. Radio receiver
AV-81
62-7F
Copyright Protection Error
1. CD
2. Radio receiver
AV-81
In-dash CD changer
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
See page
63-10
CD Changer Mechanical Error
Radio receiver
AV-69
63-11
CD Insertion and Eject Error
Radio receiver
AV-69
63-12
CD Reading Abnormal
Radio receiver
AV-69
63-40
No Disc
1. CD
2. Radio receiver
AV-70
63-41
Wrong Disc
1. CD
2. Radio receiver
AV-71
63-42
Disc cannot be Read
1. CD
2. Radio receiver
AV-71
63-43
CD-ROM Abnormal
1. CD
2. Radio receiver
AV-73
63-44
CD Abnormal
Radio receiver
AV-75
63-45
Eject Error
Radio receiver
AV-76
63-46
Scratched / Reversed Disc
1. CD
2. Radio receiver
AV-77
63-47
High Temperature
Radio receiver
AV-79
63-48
Excess Current
Radio receiver
AV-75
63-50
Tray Insertion / Ejection Error
Radio receiver
AV-75
63-51
Elevator Error
Radio receiver
AV-76
63-52
Clamp Error
Radio receiver
AV-76
63-78
DSP Error
Radio receiver
AV-80
AV–47
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
See page
63-7D
Disc cannot be Played
1. CD
2. Radio receiver
AV-81
63-7E
No Playable Files
1. CD
2. Radio receiver
AV-81
63-7F
Copyright Protection Error
1. CD
2. Radio receiver
AV-81
Speaker
DTC No.
74-40
Detection Item
Short in Speaker Circuit
Trouble Area
1. Wire harness
2. Speaker
3. Stereo component amplifier
See page
AV-82
AV
AV–48
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
01-21
ROM Error
DTC
01-22
RAM Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
01-21
A malfunction exists in ROM.
Multi-display
01-22
A malfunction exists in RAM.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
NEXT
AV
END
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLAY
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
01-D5
Absence of Registration Unit
DTC
01-D8
No Response for Connection Check
DTC
01-D9
Last Mode Error
DTC
01-DA
No Response Against ON / OFF Command
DTC
01-DB
Mode Status Error
DTC
01-DE
Slave Reset
AV–49
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
01-D5
*1, *3
Device that the sub-code shows is (was) disconnected
from system when turning power switch ON (ACC or
IG).
Communication condition with the device that the code
shows cannot be obtained when the hybrid system
starts.
•
01-D8
*2, *3
The device indicated by sub-code is (was)
disconnected from the system after the hybrid system
starts.
01-D9
*1, *3
Device that had functioned before engine stopped is
(was) disconnected from system when the power
switch is (was) ON (ACC or IG).
01-DA
*3
No response is identified when changing mode.
Sound and image do not change by switch operation.
01-DB
*1, *3
Dual alarm is detected.
01-DE
*3
Slave device has been disconnected after the hybrid
system starts.
•
•
Power source circuit of component shown by subcode
AVC-LAN circuit between multi-display and
component shown by sub-code
Component shown by sub-code
HINT:
• *1: Even if no fault is present, this trouble code may be stored depending on the battery condition or
hybrid system start voltage.
• *2: If the power connector is disconnected after the hybrid system starts, this code is stored after 180
seconds.
• *3: If the device is reported as not existing during verification, check the power source circuit and AVCLAN circuit for the device.
NOTICE:
• Before starting troubleshooting, be sure to clear DTCs to erase codes stored due to the
reasons described in the HINT above. Then, check for DTCs and troubleshoot according to the
output DTCs.
• The multi-display is the master unit.
• Be sure to clear and recheck DTCs after the inspection is completed to confirm that no DTCs
are output.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
Be sure to read DESCRIPTION before performing the following procedures.
AV
AV–50
1
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
CHECK "MULTI-DISPLAY COMMUNICATION ERROR" IN FLOWCHART
(a) Refer to the multi-display communication error (see page
AV-167).
NEXT
END
AV
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
01-D6
No Master
DTC
01-D7
Connection Check Error
AV–51
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
01-D6
*1
When either of following conditions is met:
• Device that stores (stored) code has (had) been
disconnected when power switch is ON (ACC or
IG)
• Master device has (had) been disconnected when
this code is stored
•
•
01-D7
*2
When either of following conditions is met:
• Device that stored code has (had) been
disconnected after hybrid system starts (started)
• Master device has (had) been disconnected when
this code is (was) stored
•
•
•
Multi-display power source circuit
Power source circuit of component which has
stored this code
AVC-LAN circuit between multi-display and
component which has stored this code
Component which has stored this code
Multi-display
HINT:
• *1: Even if no fault is present, this trouble code may be stored depending on the battery condition or
hybrid system start voltage.
• *2: When 210 seconds have elapsed after disconnecting the power supply connector of the master
component with the power switch ON (ACC or IG), this code is stored.
NOTICE:
• Before starting troubleshooting, be sure to clear DTCs to erase codes stored due to the
reasons described in the HINT above. Then, check for DTCs and troubleshoot according to the
output DTCs.
• The multi-display is the master unit.
• Be sure to clear and recheck DTCs after the inspection is completed to confirm that no DTCs
are output.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
Be sure to read DESCRIPTION before performing the following procedures.
1
CHECK MULTI-DISPLAY POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT
(a) Refer to the multi-display power source circuit (see page
AV-175).
If the power source circuit is operating normally, proceed to
the next step.
NEXT
AV
AV–52
2
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
IDENTIFY COMPONENT WHICH HAS STORED THIS CODE
(a) Enter the diagnostic mode.
(b) Press the "LAN Mon" switch to change to "LAN Monitor"
mode.
(c) Identify the component which has stored this code.
Component table:
Example
Display
Component
G/W
Gateway ECU
DSP-AMP
Stereo component amplifier
AUDIO H/U
Radio receiver
HINT:
"G/W" is the component which has stored this code in
the example shown in the illustration.
AV
Component which
has stored this code
DTC
Component shown by sub-code
E107226E01
NEXT
3
CHECK POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT OF COMPONENT WHICH HAS STORED THIS CODE
(a) Inspect the power source circuit of the component which
has stored this code.
If the power source circuit is operating normally, proceed
to the next step.
Component table:
Component
Proceed to
Gateway ECU (G//W)
Gateway ECU power source circuit (see page AV-177)
Stereo component amplifier (DSP-AMP)
Stereo component amplifier power source circuit (see page AV-173)
Radio receiver (AUDIO H/U)
Radio receive power source circuit (see page AV-171)
NEXT
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
4
AV–53
INSPECT RADIO RECEIVER
(a) for 9 Speaker System:
Disconnect the R5 and R6 receiver connectors.
(b) for 6 Speaker System:
Disconnect the R5 receiver connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the receiver.
Standard resistance
for 9 Speaker System
Radio Receiver
TX+
Tester Connection
R5
TX-
Specified Condition
R5-9 (TX1+) - R5-10 (TX1-)*1
60 to 80 Ω
R5-9 (TX+) - R5-10 (TX-)*2
60 to 80 Ω
R6-5 (TX+) - R6-15 (TX-)*2
60 to 80 Ω
HINT:
• *1: for 6 speaker system
• *2: for 9 speaker system
Radio Receiver
NG
R6
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
AV
TX+
TXfor 6 Speaker System
TX1+
Radio Receiver
R5
TX1E107228E01
OK
5
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (MULTI-DISPLAY - COMPONENT WHICH HAS STORED THIS
CODE)
HINT:
For details of the connectors, refer to the "TERMINALS OF
ECU" (see page AV-31).
(a) Referring to the AVC-LAN wiring diagram below, check
the AVC-LAN circuit between the multi-display and the
component which has stored this code.
(1) Disconnect all connectors between the multi-display
and the component which has stored this code.
(2) Check for an open or short in the AVC-LAN circuit
between the multi-display and the component which
has stored this code.
AV–54
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
OK:
There is no open or short circuit.
AVC-LAN Wiring Diagram
Multi-display
Gateway ECU
GTX+
Slave Unit
TX1+
Radio Receiver
TX1+*1
TX+*2
TX2+
Master Unit
GTX-
TX1-
TX1-*1
TX-*2
TX2-
Slave Unit
AV
Stereo Component Amplifier*2
TX+*2
*1: for 6 Speaker System
Slave Unit
TX-*2
*2: for 9 Speaker System
*2
*2
TX+*2
TX-*2
E126611E01
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
6
REPLACE COMPONENT WHICH HAS STORED THIS CODE
(a) Replace the component which has stored this code with
a normal one and check if the same problem occurs
again.
OK:
Same problem does not occur.
NG
OK
END
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLAY
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
01-DC
AV–55
Transmission Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
01-DC
Transmission to component shown by sub-code is
failed (Detecting this DTC does not always mean actual
failure)
If same sub-code is recorded in other components,
check harness for power supply and communication
system of all components shown by code
NOTICE:
• The multi-display is the master unit.
• Be sure to clear and recheck DTCs after the inspection is completed to confirm that no DTCs
are output.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
Be sure to read DESCRIPTION before performing the following procedures.
1
CHECK FOR DTC OF OTHER COMPONENTS
(a) Check if the component shown by the sub-code is
displayed in the check result of the other components.
(1) Check if "01-DC" is output for the other
components.
(2) If "01-DC" is output for any other components,
check if the same physical address is displayed.
Result
Result
Proceed to
"01-DC" is output and same physical
address is displayed
A
"01-DC" is not output or same physical
address is not displayed
B
HINT:
For the list of the components shown by sub-codes,
refer to the table in the step below.
B
A
Go to step 4
AV
AV–56
2
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
IDENTIFY COMPONENT WHICH HAS STORED THIS CODE
(a) Enter the diagnostic mode.
(b) Press the "LAN Mon" switch to change to "LAN Monitor"
mode.
(c) Identify the component which has stored this code.
Component table:
Example
Display
Component
G/W
Gateway ECU
DSP-AMP
Stereo component amplifier
EMV
Multi-display
AUDIO H/U
Radio receiver
HINT:
"G/W" is the component which has stored this code in
the example shown in the illustration.
AV
Component which
has stored this code
DTC
Component shown by sub-code
E107226E01
NEXT
3
CHECK COMPONENT WHICH HAS STORED THIS CODE
(a) Select the component which has stored this code.
Component table:
Component
Proceed to
Gateway ECU (G/W)
Gateway ECU communication error (see page AV-155)
Stereo component amplifier (DSP-AMP)
Stereo component amplifier communication error (see page AV-163)
Multi-display (EMV)
Multi-display communication error (see page AV-167)
Radio receiver (AUDIO H/U)
Radio receiver communication error (see page AV-159)
NEXT
END
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
4
AV–57
CLEAR DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (see page AV-37).
HINT:
If "01-DC" is output for only one component, this may not
indicate a malfunction.
NEXT
5
RECHECK DTC
(a) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble code
occurs again.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NG
Go to step 3
OK
END
AV
AV–58
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
01-DD
Master Reset
DTC
01-E1
Voice Processing Device ON Error
DESCRIPTION
AV
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
01-DD
Device that should be master has been disconnected
after hybrid system start
•
•
01-E1
*
AMP device records that AMP output does not function
even while source device operates
•
•
Multi-display power source circuit
AVC-LAN circuit between multi-display and
component which has stored this code
Multi-display
Component which has stored this code
HINT:
*: Even if no fault is present, this trouble code may be stored depending on the battery condition or hybrid
system start voltage.
NOTICE:
• Before starting troubleshooting, be sure to clear DTCs to erase codes stored due to the
reasons described in the HINT above. Then, check for DTCs and troubleshoot according to the
output DTCs.
• The multi-display is the master unit.
• Be sure to clear and recheck DTCs after the inspection is completed to confirm that no DTCs
are output.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
Be sure to read DESCRIPTION before performing the following procedures.
1
CHECK MULTI-DISPLAY POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT
(a) Refer to the multi-display power source circuit (see page
AV-175).
If the power source circuit is operating normally, proceed
to the next step.
NEXT
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
2
AV–59
INSPECT RADIO RECEIVER
(a) for 9 Speaker System:
Disconnect the R5 and R6 receiver connectors.
(b) for 6 Speaker System:
Disconnect the R5 receiver connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the receiver.
Standard resistance
for 9 Speaker System
Radio Receiver
TX+
Tester Connection
R5
TX-
Specified Condition
R5-9 (TX1+) - R5-10 (TX1-)*1
60 to 80 Ω
R5-9 (TX+) - R5-10 (TX-)*2
60 to 80 Ω
R6-5 (TX+) - R6-15 (TX-)*2
60 to 80 Ω
HINT:
• *1: for 6 speaker system
• *2: for 9 speaker system
Radio Receiver
NG
R6
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
AV
TX+
TXfor 6 Speaker System
TX1+
Radio Receiver
R5
TX1E107228E01
OK
AV–60
3
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
IDENTIFY COMPONENT WHICH HAS STORED THIS CODE
(a) Enter the diagnostic mode.
(b) Press the "LAN Mon" switch to change to "LAN Monitor"
Mode.
(c) Identify the component which has stored this code.
Component table
Example
Display
Component
G/W
Gateway ECU
DSP-AMP
Stereo component amplifier
AUDIO H/U
Radio Receiver
HINT:
"G/W" is the component which has stored this code in
the example shown in the illustration.
AV
Component which
has stored this code
DTC
Component shown by sub-code
E107226E01
NEXT
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (MULTI-DISPLAY - COMPONENT WHICH HAS STORED THIS
CODE)
HINT:
For details of the connectors, refer to the "TERMINALS OF
ECU" (see page AV-31).
(a) Referring to the AVC-LAN wiring diagram below, check
the AVC-LAN circuit between the multi-display and the
component which has stored this code.
(1) Disconnect all connectors between the multi-display
and the component which has stored this code.
(2) Check for an open or short in the AVC-LAN circuit
between the multi-display and the component which
has stored this code.
AV–61
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
OK:
There is no open or short circuit.
AVC-LAN Wiring Diagram
Multi-display
Gateway ECU
GTX+
Slave Unit
TX1+
Radio Receiver
TX1+*1
TX+*2
TX2+
Master Unit
GTX-
TX1-
TX1-*1
TX-*2
TX2-
Slave Unit
AV
Stereo Component Amplifier*2
TX+*2
*1: for 6 Speaker System
Slave Unit
TX-*2
*2: for 9 Speaker System
*2
*2
TX+*2
TX-*2
E126611E01
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
5
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLAY
(a) Replace the multi-display with a normal one and check if
the same problem occurs again.
OK:
Same problem does not occur.
NG
OK
END
REPLACE COMPONENT WHICH HAS
STORED THIS CODE
AV–62
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
01-DF
Master Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
01-DF
*
Device with display fails and master is switched to
audio device.
Also when communication error between sub-master
(audio) and master occurs, this code is stored.
•
•
•
•
Multi-display power source circuit
AVC-LAN circuit between multi-display and
component which has stored this code
Multi-display
Component which has stored this code
HINT:
*: When 210 seconds have elapsed after disconnecting the power supply connector of the master
component with the power switch ON (ACC or IG), this code is stored.
NOTICE:
• Before starting troubleshooting, be sure to clear DTCs to erase codes stored due to the
reasons described in the HINT above. Then, check for DTCs and troubleshoot according to the
output DTCs.
• The multi-display is the master unit.
• Be sure to clear and recheck DTCs after the inspection is completed to confirm that no DTCs
are output.
AV
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
Be sure to read DESCRIPTION before performing the following procedures.
1
CHECK MULTI-DISPLAY POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT
(a) Refer to the multi-display power source circuit (see page
AV-175).
If the power source circuit is operating normally, proceed
to the next step.
NEXT
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
2
AV–63
INSPECT RADIO RECEIVER
(a) for 9 Speaker System:
Disconnect the R5 and R6 receiver connectors.
(b) for 6 Speaker System:
Disconnect the R5 receiver connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the receiver.
Standard resistance
for 9 Speaker System
Radio Receiver
TX+
Tester Connection
R5
TX-
Specified Condition
R5-9 (TX1+) - R5-10 (TX1-)*1
60 to 80 Ω
R5-9 (TX+) - R5-10 (TX-)*2
60 to 80 Ω
R6-5 (TX+) - R6-15 (TX-)*2
60 to 80 Ω
HINT:
• *1: for 6 speaker system
• *2: for 9 speaker system
Radio Receiver
NG
R6
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
AV
TX+
TXfor 6 Speaker System
TX1+
Radio Receiver
R5
TX1E107228E01
OK
AV–64
3
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
IDENTIFY COMPONENT WHICH HAS STORED THIS CODE
(a) Enter the diagnostic mode.
(b) Press the "LAN Mon" switch to change to "LAN Monitor"
mode.
(c) Identify the component which has stored this code.
Component table:
Example
Display
Component
G/W
Gateway ECU
DSP-AMP
Stereo component amplifier
AUDIO H/U
Radio Receiver
HINT:
"G/W" is the component which has stored this code in
the example shown in the illustration.
AV
Component which
has stored this code
DTC
Component shown by sub-code
E107226E01
NEXT
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (MULTI-DISPLAY - COMPONENT WHICH HAS STORED THIS
CODE)
HINT:
For details of the connectors, refer to the "TERMINALS OF
ECU" (see page AV-31).
(a) Referring to the AVC-LAN wiring diagram below, check
the AVC-LAN circuit between the multi-display and the
component which has stored this code.
(1) Disconnect all connectors between the multi-display
and the component which has stored this code.
(2) Check for an open or short in the AVC-LAN circuit
between the multi-display and the component which
has stored this code.
AV–65
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
OK:
There is no open or short circuit.
AVC-LAN Wiring Diagram
Multi-display
Gateway ECU
GTX+
Slave Unit
TX1+
Radio Receiver
TX1+*1
TX+*2
TX2+
Master Unit
GTX-
TX1-
TX1-*1
TX-*2
TX2-
Slave Unit
AV
Stereo Component Amplifier*2
TX+*2
*1: for 6 Speaker System
Slave Unit
TX-*2
*2: for 9 Speaker System
*2
*2
TX+*2
TX-*2
E126611E01
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
5
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLAY
(a) Replace the multi-display with a normal one and check if
the same problem occurs again.
OK:
Same problem does not occur.
NG
OK
END
REPLACE COMPONENT WHICH HAS
STORED THIS CODE
AV–66
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
01-E0
Registration Complete Indication Error
DTC
01-E3
Registration Demand Transmission
DTC
01-E4
Multiple Frame Incomplete
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
01-E0
"Registration complete" signal from master device
cannot be received.
-
01-E3
Registration demand signal from slave device is output.
Or registration demand signal is output by receiving
connection confirmation signal from sub-master device.
-
01-E4
Multiple frame transmission is incomplete.
-
HINT:
Even if no fault is present, these trouble codes may be stored depending on the battery condition or hybrid
system start voltage.
AV
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs. These DTCs do not indicate a malfunction.
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
01-E2
AV–67
ON / OFF Indication Parameter Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
01-E2
Command for ON / OFF control from master device has
problem.
Multi-display
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLAY
NEXT
END
AV
AV–68
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
57-47
Bluetooth Module Initialization Failed
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
57-47
When one of following conditions is met:
• Bluetooth module is not installed
• Problem with Bluetooth module
• Problem in communication line to Bluetooth module
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
NEXT
AV
END
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLAY
Trouble Area
Multi-display
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
60-10
AM Tuner PLL does not Lock Error
DTC
60-11
FM Tuner PLL does not Lock Error
AV–69
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
60-10
AM tuner PLL (phase locked loop) synchronization is
impossible.
Radio receiver
60-11
FM tuner PLL (phase locked loop) synchronization is
impossible.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
NEXT
END
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
AV
AV–70
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
60-42
Tuner Power Source Error
DTC
60-43
AM Tuner Error
DTC
60-44
FM Tuner Error
DTC
60-50
Malfunction in Internal IC
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
60-42
Power source of tuner is abnormal.
Radio receiver
60-43
AM tuner is abnormal.
60-44
FM tuner is abnormal.
60-50
Problem occurs in IC inside tuner unit and radio
reception is not normal.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
AV
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CLEAR DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (see page AV-37).
NEXT
2
RECHECK DTC
(a) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble occurs
again.
HINT:
If DTCs are detected frequently, replace the radio
receiver.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NG
OK
END
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
62-10
CD Player Mechanical Error
DTC
62-11
CD Insertion and Eject Error
DTC
62-12
CD Reading Abnormal
DTC
63-10
CD Changer Mechanical Error
DTC
63-11
CD Insertion and Eject Error
DTC
63-12
CD Reading Abnormal
AV–71
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
62-10
Mechanical error in CD player is detected
while CD is not being inserted or ejected.
Radio receiver
62-11
CD insertion or ejection is failed.
62-12
CD read problem occurs.
63-10
Mechanical error in CD changer is detected
while CD is not being inserted or ejected.
63-11
CD insertion or ejection is failed.
63-12
CD read problem occurs.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
NEXT
END
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
AV
AV–72
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
62-40
No Disc
DTC
63-40
No Disc
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
62-40
No disc is inserted.
Radio receiver
63-40
No disc is inserted.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CHECK RADIO RECEIVER
(a) Check if a disc is inserted.
OK:
A disc is inserted.
AV
OK
NG
END
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
62-41
Wrong Disc
DTC
62-42
Disc cannot be Read
DTC
63-41
Wrong Disc
DTC
63-42
Disc cannot be Read
AV–73
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
62-41
Unsuitable disc is inserted.
•
•
62-42
The disc cannot be read.
63-41
Unsuitable disc is inserted.
63-42
The disc cannot be read.
CD
Radio receiver
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
AV
CHECK DISC
(a) Check that the disc is not deformed or cracked.
OK:
No deformation or cracks on the disc.
NG
CHANGE DISC
I100152
OK
2
CLEAN DISC
(a) If dirt is on the disc surface, wipe it clean with a soft cloth
from the inside to the outside in a radial direction.
NOTICE:
Do not use a conventional record cleaner or antistatic preservative.
I100151
NEXT
AV–74
3
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
CLEAR DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (see page AV-37).
NEXT
4
RECHECK DTC
(a) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble occurs
again.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
OK
END
NG
5
REPLACE DISC
(a) Replace the disc with another and recheck.
(1) Replace the disc with a normal one.
(2) Clear the DTCs (see page AV-37).
(3) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble
occurs again.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
AV
NG
OK
END
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
62-43
CD-ROM Abnormal
DTC
63-43
CD-ROM Abnormal
AV–75
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
62-43
CD-ROM operation is abnormal
63-43
CD-ROM operation is abnormal
•
•
CD
Radio receiver
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CHECK IF A PROPER CD IS INSERTED
(a) Make sure that the CD is an audio CD or a CD with an
MP3 or WMA file, and that it is not deformed, flawed,
stained, burred, or otherwise defective.
OK:
Normal CD
HINT:
• Translucent or uniquely-shaped CDs cannot be
played.
• CDs with adhesive paper labels should not be played.
• Commercial audio CDs can be played.
• CD-DA files on CD-ROMs, CD-Rs, and CD-RWs can
be played.
• MP3 and WMA files on CD-ROMs, CD-Rs, and CDRWs can be played.
• For details on playable CDs, refer to the Owner's
Manual.
NG
CD IS FAULTY
OK
2
REPLACE CD
(a) Replace the CD with another and recheck.
(1) Replace the CD with a normal one.
(2) Clear the DTCs (see page AV-37).
(3) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble
occurs again.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NG
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
AV
AV–76
OK
END
AV
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–77
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
62-44
CD Abnormal
DTC
62-48
Excess Current
DTC
62-50
Tray Insertion / Ejection Error
DTC
63-44
CD Abnormal
DTC
63-48
Excess Current
DTC
63-50
Tray Insertion / Ejection Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
62-44
Operation error in CD mechanism
62-48
Excess current is present in CD player
62-50
Malfunction in insertion / ejection system
63-44
Operation error in CD mechanism
63-48
Excess current is present in CD changer
63-50
Malfunction in insertion / ejection system
Trouble Area
Radio receiver
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CLEAR DTC
(a) Clear the DTC (see page AV-37).
NEXT
2
RECHECK DTC
(a) Recheck DTCs and check if the same trouble occurs
again.
HINT:
If DTCs are detected frequently, replace the radio
receiver.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NG
OK
END
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
AV
AV–78
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
62-45
Eject Error
DTC
62-51
Elevator Error
DTC
62-52
Clamp Error
DTC
63-45
Eject Error
DTC
63-51
Elevator Error
DTC
63-52
Clamp Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
AV
DTC Detection Condition
62-45
Disc cannot be ejected.
62-51
Mechanical error occurs during elevator
operation.
62-52
Error occurs in CD player clamp.
63-45
Magazine cannot be ejected.
63-51
Mechanical error occurs during elevator
operation.
63-52
Error occurs in CD changer clamp.
Trouble Area
Radio receiver
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CHECK RADIO RECEIVER
(a) Check if a disc can be changed, inserted or ejected
normally.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NG
OK
END
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
62-46
Scratched / Reversed Disc
DTC
63-46
Scratched / Reversed Disc
AV–79
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
62-46
Scratches or dirt is found on CD surface or CD is
inserted upside down.
•
•
63-46
Scratches or dirt is found on CD surface or CD is
inserted upside down.
CD
Radio receiver
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CHECK THAT CD IS INSERTED PROPERLY
(a) Check that the CD is not inserted upside down.
OK:
CD is properly inserted.
NG
INSERT CD PROPERLY
OK
2
CHECK DISC
(a) Check that the disc is not deformed or cracked.
OK:
No deformation or cracks on the disc.
NG
I100152
OK
REPLACE DISC
AV
AV–80
3
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
CLEAN DISC
(a) If dirt is on the disc surface, wipe it clean with a soft cloth
from the inside to the outside in a radial direction.
NOTICE:
Do not use a conventional record cleaner or antistatic preservative.
I100151
NEXT
4
CLEAR DISC
(a) Clear the DTCs (see page AV-37).
AV
NEXT
5
RECHECK DTC
(a) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble occurs
again.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
OK
END
NG
6
REPLACE DISC
(a) Replace the disc with another and recheck.
(1) Replace the disc with a normal one.
(2) Clear the DTCs (see page AV-37).
(3) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble
occurs again.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NG
OK
END
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
62-47
High Temperature
DTC
63-47
High Temperature
AV–81
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
62-47
Sensor detects that CD unit temperature is high
(Over 80°C (176.0°F))
Radio receiver
63-47
Sensor detects that CD unit temperature is high
(Over 80°C (176.0°F))
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear DTCs.
1
CHECK RADIO RECEIVER
(a) Park the vehicle in a cool place.
(b) Check that the temperature of the radio receiver
becomes sufficiently low, then start the hybrid system.
(c) Clear DTC and recheck.
(d) Check if DTC 62-47 or 63-47 is output.
OK:
DTC 62-47 or 63-47 is not output.
NG
OK
END
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
AV
AV–82
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
62-78
DSP Error
DTC
63-78
DSP Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
62-78
Error occurs during the decode process (MP3/WMA)
Radio receiver
63-78
Error occurs during the decode process (MP3/WMA)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
NOTICE:
• This code may be output even if there is no malfunction.
• If this code is output frequently, replace the radio receiver.
1
CLEAR DTC
AV
(a) Clear the DTCs (see page AV-37).
NEXT
2
RECHECK DTC
(a) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble code
occurs again.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NG
OK
END
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
DTC
62-7D
Disc cannot be Played
DTC
62-7E
No Playable Files
DTC
62-7F
Copyright Protection Error
DTC
63-7D
Disc cannot be Played
DTC
63-7E
No Playable Files
DTC
63-7F
Copyright Protection Error
AV–83
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
62-7D
When either condition below is met:
• Incompatible MP3/WMA file is used.
• Although the file has an extension of ".mp3" or
".wma", the header information cannot be read.
•
•
62-7E
When either condition below is met:
• Disc with no music data is used.
• Playable files are not on the disc (MP3/WMA).
62-7F
A copy-protected file, which cannot be played, is used.
63-7D
When either condition below is met:
• Incompatible MP3/WMA file is used.
• Although file has an extension of ".mp3" or ".wma",
the header information cannot be read.
63-7E
When either condition below is met:
• Disc with no music data is used.
• Playable files are not on the disc (MP3/WMA).
63-7F
A copy-protected file, which cannot be played, is used.
CD
Radio receiver
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CHANGE DISC
(a) Insert a disc with a playable file and check if the disc can
be played correctly.
HINT:
For details on playable files and discs, refer to the
Owner's Manual.
OK:
The disc can be played correctly.
NG
OK
DISC IS FAULTY
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
AV
AV–84
DTC
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
74-40
Short in Speaker Circuit
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
74-40
Short is detected in speaker output circuit.
•
•
•
Wire harness
Speaker
Stereo component amplifier
This circuit has a fail-safe function.
• When a short in the speaker circuit is detected, all sound outputs are stopped.
AV
AV–85
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
for 6 Speaker System
Radio Receiver
Front No. 2 Speaker LH
FL+
Front No. 1 Speaker LH
FL-
Front No. 2 Speaker RH
FR+
Front No. 1 Speaker RH
AV
FR-
RL+
Rear No. 1 Speaker LH
RL-
RR+
Rear No.1 Speaker RH
RR-
E107207E01
AV–86
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
for 9 Speaker System
Stereo Component Amplifier
FLFront No. 2 Speaker LH
FL+
FRFront No. 2 Speaker RH
AV
FR+
WFLFront No. 1 Speaker LH
WFL+
WFRFront No. 1 Speaker RH
WFR+
E107208E01
AV–87
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
CTRFront Stereo Component Speaker
CTR+
Rear No. 2 Speaker LH
RL-
AV
Rear No. 1 Speaker LH
RL+
Rear No. 2 Speaker RH
RRRear No. 1 Speaker RH
RR+
E107209E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
AV–88
1
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
CHECK VEHICLE EQUIPMENT
Vehicle equipment
Vehicle equipment
Proceed to
6 speaker system
A
9 speaker system
B
B
Go to step 9
A
2
INSPECT RADIO RECEIVER
(a) Disconnect the R3 and R4 receiver connectors.
(b) Clear DTC and recheck.
(c) Check if DTC 74-40 is output.
OK:
DTC 74-40 is not output.
NG
AV
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
OK
3
CHECK OPERATION
(a) Reconnect the R3 and R4 receiver connectors.
(b) Check if DTC 74-40 is output.
OK:
DTC 74-40 is not output.
OK
NG
END
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
4
AV–89
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (RADIO RECEIVER - SPEAKER)
(a) Disconnect the R3 and R4 receiver connectors.
(b) Disconnect the T6, T7, R11 and R12 speaker
connectors.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Radio Receiver
FR+
R3
FL+
FR-
FL-
Radio Receiver
RR+
R4
RR-
RL+
RL-
*1
T7 *2
Rear No. 1 Speaker LH*1, RH*2
R11
*1
R12 *2
*1: for LH
*2: for RH
E107212E03
OK
Specified Condition
R3-2 (FL+) - T6-4
Below 1 Ω
R3-6 (FL-) - T6-2
Below 1 Ω
R3-1 (FR+) - T7-4
Below 1 Ω
R3-5 (FR-) - T7-2
Below 1 Ω
R4-2 (RL+) - R11-1
Below 1 Ω
R4-6 (RL-) - R11-2
Below 1 Ω
R4-1 (RR+) - R12-1
Below 1 Ω
R4-3 (RR-) - R12-2
Below 1 Ω
NG
Front No. 2 Speaker LH*1, RH*2
T6
Tester Connection
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
AV
AV–90
5
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (FRONT NO. 1 SPEAKER - FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER)
(a) Disconnect the F12, F13, T6 and T7 speaker
connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Front No. 1 Speaker LH*1, RH*2
F12 *1
F13 *2
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
F12-1 - T6-3
Below 1 Ω
F12-2 - T6-1
Below 1 Ω
F13-1 - T7-3
Below 1 Ω
F13-2 - T7-1
Below 1 Ω
NG
Front No. 2 Speaker LH*1, RH*2
T6 *1
T7 *2
AV
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
*1: for LH
*2: for RH
E107213E04
OK
6
INSPECT FRONT NO. 1 SPEAKER
(a) Disconnect the F12 and F13 speaker connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance of the speaker.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1-2
Approximately 4 Ω
NG
REPLACE FRONT NO. 1 SPEAKER
E107214
OK
7
INSPECT FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER
(a) Check that the malfunction disappears when the speaker
is replaced with a normal one.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
HINT:
• Connect all the connectors to the front No. 2
speakers.
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–91
• When there is a possibility that either the right or left
front speaker is defective, inspect by interchanging
the right one with the left one.
• Perform the inspection above on both LH and RH
sides.
NG
REPLACE FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER
OK
8
INSPECT REAR NO. 1 SPEAKER
(a) Disconnect the R11 and R12 speaker connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance of the speaker.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1-2
Approximately 4 Ω
NG
REPLACE REAR NO. 1 SPEAKER
AV
E107214
OK
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
9
INSPECT STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER
(a) Disconnect the S14 and S29 amplifier connectors.
(b) Clear DTC and recheck.
(c) Check if DTC 70-40 is output.
OK:
DTC 74-40 is not output.
NG
REPLACE STEREO COMPONENT
AMPLIFIER
OK
10
CHECK OPERATION
(a) Reconnect the S14 and S29 amplifier connectors.
(b) Check that audio can be heard from the speaker.
OK:
Audio can be heard.
OK
NG
END
AV–92
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
11
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER - SPEAKER)
(a) Disconnect the S14 and S29 amplifier connectors.
(b) Disconnect the C8, F12, F13, T6, T7, T8 and T9 speaker
connectors.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Stereo Component Amplifier
RL+
FR+
S14
FR- FL-
FL+
RR-
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S29-2 (WFL+) - F12-1
Below 1 Ω
RR+
S29-1 (WFL-) - F12-2
Below 1 Ω
RL-
Stereo Component Amplifier
S29
CTR+
WFL-
AV
WFL+
WFR- WFR+
CTR-
Front No. 1 Speaker LH*1, RH*2
S29-9 (WFR+) - F13-1
Below 1 Ω
S29-3 (WFR-) - F13-2
Below 1 Ω
S14-8 (FL+) - T6-4
Below 1 Ω
S14-7 (FL-) - T6-2
Below 1 Ω
S14-2 (FR+) - T7-4
Below 1 Ω
S14-6 (FR-) - T7-2
Below 1 Ω
S14-3 (RL+) - T8-4
Below 1 Ω
S14-9 (RL-) - T8-2
Below 1 Ω
S14-10 (RR+) - T9-4
Below 1 Ω
S14-4 (RR-) - T9-2
Below 1 Ω
S29-4 (CTR+) - C8-2
Below 1 Ω
S29-10 (CTR-) - C8-1
Below 1 Ω
NG
F12 *1
F13 *2
Front No. 2 Speaker LH*1, RH*2
Rear No. 2 Speaker LH*3, RH*4
T6 *1
T7 *2
T8 *3
T9 *4
Front Stereo Component Speaker
C8
E107215E03
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–93
OK
12
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (REAR NO. 1 SPEAKER - REAR NO. 2 SPEAKER)
(a) Disconnect the R11, R12, T8 and T9 speaker
connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Rear No. 1 Speaker LH*1, RH*2
R11 *1
R12 *2
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
R11-1 - T8-3
Below 1 Ω
R11-2 - T8-1
Below 1 Ω
R12-1 - T9-3
Below 1 Ω
R12-2 - T9-1
Below 1 Ω
NG
Rear No. 2 Speaker LH*1, RH*2
T8 *1
*2
T9
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
AV
*1: for LH
*2: for RH
E107213E05
OK
13
INSPECT FRONT NO. 1 SPEAKER
(a) Disconnect the F12 and F13 speaker connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance of the speaker.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1-2
Approximately 4 Ω
NG
REPLACE FRONT NO. 1 SPEAKER
E107214
OK
14
INSPECT FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER
(a) Check that the malfunction disappears when the speaker
is replaced with a normal one.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
HINT:
• Connect all the connectors to the front No. 2
speakers.
AV–94
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
• When there is a possibility that either the right or left
front speaker is defective, inspect by interchanging
the right one with the left one.
• Perform the inspection above on both LH and RH
sides.
NG
REPLACE FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER
OK
15
INSPECT REAR NO. 1 SPEAKER
(a) Disconnect the R11 and R12 speaker connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance of the speaker.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1-2
Approximately 4 Ω
NG
AV
REPLACE REAR NO. 1 SPEAKER
E107214
OK
16
INSPECT REAR NO. 2 SPEAKER
(a) Check that the malfunction disappears when the speaker
is replaced with a normal one.
OK: :
Malfunction disappears.
HINT:
• Connect all the connectors to the rear No. 2 speakers.
• When there is a possibility that either the right or left
rear speaker is defective, inspect by interchanging the
right one with the left one.
• Perform the inspection above on both LH and RH
sides.
NG
OK
REPLACE REAR NO. 2 SPEAKER
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
17
AV–95
INSPECT FRONT STEREO COMPONENT SPEAKER
(a) Disconnect the C8 speaker connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the speaker.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1-2
1.2 to 2.2 Ω
NG
REPLACE FRONT STEREO COMPONENT
SPEAKER
E116557
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AV
AV–96
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Noise Occurs
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
NOISE CONDITION
(a) Check in which direction the noise comes from (front left
or right, or rear left or right).
OK:
The location of the noise source can be
determined.
NG
Go to step 3
OK
2
AV
CHECK SPEAKER
(a) Check the installation conditions of the speaker units that
are located near the noise source and that there are no
cracks, scratches, deformation, or other failures.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
Speaker is installed incorrectly
A
Foreign objects are in speaker
B
Speaker cone paper is broken
C
No malfunction is found
D
A
REINSTALL SPEAKER
B
REMOVE FOREIGN OBJECT
C
REPLACE SPEAKER
D
3
CHECK NOISE CONDITIONS
(a) Check the noise condition.
HINT:
The radio has a noise prevention function to reduce
noise when listening to the radio. If a loud noise occurs,
check whether the ground at the antenna mounting base
and the noise prevention unit are installed and wired
correctly.
Conditions under which noise occurs
Noise Source
Noise increases when the accelerator pedal is depressed, but stops when the hybrid system is
stopped.
Generator
Noise occurs during A/C or heater operation.
Blower motor
Noise occurs when the vehicle accelerates rapidly on an unpaved road or after the power switch is
turned ON (IG).
Fuel pump
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Conditions under which noise occurs
Noise Source
Noise occurs when the horn switch is pressed and released or when pressed and held.
Horn
Noise occurs synchronously with the blink of the turn signal.
Flasher
Noise occurs during window washer operation.
Washer
Noise occurs while the hybrid system is running, and continues even after the hybrid system is
stopped.
Water temperature sensor
Noise occurs during wiper operation.
Wiper
Noise occurs when the brake pedal is depressed.
Stop light switch
Other
Static electricity
AV–97
HINT:
• In the chart's left column, find the situation that
matches the customer's complaint. Then, in the right
column, find the part that is causing the noise. Check
the noise filter on or for the part.
• To save time and avoid a misdiagnosis, first make
sure that the noise is not coming from outside the
vehicle.
• Noise should be removed in descending order of
loudness.
• Setting the radio to a frequency where no signal is
received may make recognition of the noise problem
easier.
OK:
The noise source can be determined.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE NOISE SOURCE
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AV
AV–98
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Pressing Power Switch does not Turn on System
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK VEHICLE CONDITION
(a) Check that conditions in the cabin are not likely to cause
condensation.
HINT:
This problem occurs when the cabin is humid and the
temperature changes rapidly. This may produce
condensation, resulting in a short circuit.
OK:
Condensation is not likely to be produced.
NG
DRY OUT CABIN
OK
AV
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–99
No Sound can be Heard from Speakers
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK RADIO RECEIVER
(a) Check the radio receiver setting.
(1) Check that the volume is not set to "0".
(2) Check that "MUTE" is off.
OK:
The volume is not set to "0" and "MUTE" is off.
NG
TURN "MUTE" OFF OR RAISE VOLUME
ABOVE 0
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AV
AV–100
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Sound Quality is Bad Only when CD is Played (Volume is Too Low)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
REPLACE CD
(a) Replace the CD with another one and recheck.
(1) Check if the problem recurs using another CD.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NG
OK
END
AV
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–101
CD cannot be Ejected
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK OPERATION
(a) Press the CD EJECT switch of the radio receiver for 2
seconds or more and check that the CD is ejected.
OK:
CD is ejected.
NG
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
OK
2
REPLACE CD
(a) Insert another CD and check if it is ejected.
OK:
CD is ejected.
NG
OK
END
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
AV
AV–102
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
CD cannot be Inserted / Played or CD is Ejected Right After Insertion
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK IF PROPER CD IS INSERTED
(a) Make sure that the CD is an audio CD or a CD with an
MP3 or WMA file, and that it is not deformed, flawed,
stained, burred, or otherwise defective.
OK:
Normal CD.
HINT:
• Translucent or uniquely-shaped CDs cannot be
played.
• CDs with adhesive paper labels should not be played.
• Commercial audio CDs can be played.
• CD-DA files on CD-ROMs, CD-Rs, and CD-RWs can
be played.
• MP3 and WMA files on CD-ROMs, CD-Rs, and CDRWs can be played.
• For details on playable CDs, refer to the Owner's
Manual.
AV
NG
REPLACE CD
OK
2
CHECK THAT CD IS INSERTED PROPERLY
(a) Check whether or not the CD is inserted upside down.
OK:
CD is properly inserted.
NG
INSERT CD PROPERLY
OK
3
CLEAN CD
(a) Clean the disc by wiping it with a soft cloth from the
inside to the outside in a radial direction.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NOTICE:
Do not use a conventional record cleaner or antistatic preservative.
OK
I100151
NG
END
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
4
AV–103
REPLACE CD
(a) Replace the CD with a normal one and check that the
malfunction disappears.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NG
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
OK
END
AV
AV–104
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
CD Sound Skips
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CD
(a) Check the CD.
OK:
The CD is clean.
HINT:
If dirt is on the CD surface, wipe it clean with a soft cloth
from the inside to the outside in a radial direction.
NOTICE:
Do not use a conventional record cleaner or antistatic preservative.
I100151
NG
CLEAN CD
OK
AV
2
CHECK CD
(a) Check that the CD is not deformed or cracked.
OK:
No deformation or cracks on the CD.
NG
REPLACE CD
I100152
OK
3
CHECK OPERATION
(a) Check using another CD.
(1) Check if the problem recurs using another CD.
OK:
The problem does not occur.
OK
END
NG
4
CHECK RADIO RECEIVER
(a) Check the radio receiver installation condition.
(1) Check that the radio receiver is properly installed.
OK:
Radio receiver is properly installed.
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
NG
AV–105
REINSTALL RADIO RECEIVER PROPERLY
OK
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
AV
AV–106
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Radio Broadcast cannot be Received or Poor Reception
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK RADIO RECEIVER
(a) Check the radio's automatic station search function.
(1) Move the vehicle to a location where radio wave
reception is possible.
(2) Check the radio's automatic station search function
by activating it.
OK:
The radio's automatic station search function
works properly.
OK
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
NG
AV
2
CHECK RADIO RECEIVER
(a) Disconnect the R3*1 or R6*2 receiver connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the receiver.
Standard voltage
for 9 Speaker System
Radio Receiver
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
R3-8 (ANT+) - Body
ground*1
Power switch ON (IG),
Radio switch ON
10 to 14 V
R6-13 (ANT+) - Body
ground*2
HINT:
• *1: for 6 speaker system
• *2: for 9 speaker system
R6
for 6 Speaker System
ANT+
NG
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
Radio Receiver
R3
4 3
2 1
10 9 8 7 6 5
ANT+
E107233E01
OK
3
CHECK OPTIONAL COMPONENTS
(a) Check optional components (sunshade film, telephone
antenna, etc.).
(1) Check if any optional components, such as
sunshade film or telephone antenna, that may
decrease reception capacity are installed.
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–107
OK:
Optional components are installed.
NOTICE:
Do not remove any optional components
installed by the customer without consent.
OK
REMOVE OPTIONAL COMPONENTS AND
CHECK AGAIN (SEE NOTICE ABOVE)
NG
4
CHECK RADIO RECEIVER
E050367
(a) Preparation for check
(1) Remove the antenna plug from the radio receiver.
(b) Check for noise
(1) Turn the power switch ON (ACC) with the radio
receiver connector connected.
(2) Turn the radio on and change to AM mode.
(3) Place a screwdriver, thin wire, or other metal object
on the radio receiver's antenna jack and check that
noise can be heard from the speaker.
OK:
Noise occurs.
NG
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
OK
5
CHECK ANTENNA CORD
(a) Remove the antenna plug of the radio receiver and
antenna.
(b) Measure the resistance between the antenna cord's
inner conductor and radio receiver to check for an open
circuit in the antenna cord.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
(c) Measure the resistance between the antenna cord's
inner conductor and body ground to check for a short
circuit in the antenna cord.
Standard resistance:
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPLACE ANTENNA CORD
OK
6
REPLACE AMPLIFIER ANTENNA
(a) Replace the amplifier antenna and check if radio
broadcasts can be received normally.
OK:
Radio broadcasts can be received.
AV
AV–108
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
OK
NG
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
AV
END
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–109
Poor Sound Quality in All Modes (Low Volume)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK AUDIO SETTINGS
(a) Set "BASS", "MID", and "TREB" to the initial values and
check that sound is normal.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
OK
END
NG
2
COMPARE WITH ANOTHER VEHICLE OF SAME MODEL
(a) Compare with another vehicle of the same model which
does not have trouble to see if there is any difference in
the sound quality.
OK:
No difference is found.
OK
END
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AV
AV–110
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Cellular Phone Registration Failure, Phone Directory Transfer Failure
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CURRENT CONDITION
(a) Check for Bluetooth capable cellular phones and
vehicles in the area.
Result:
Conditions
Proceed to
Another Bluetooth compatible cellular phone is present
A
Another Bluetooth compatible vehicle is present
B
None of the above
C
B
Go to step 3
C
Go to step 4
A
AV
2
CHECK USING ANOTHER CELLULAR PHONE
(a) Check if the system functions using another Bluetooth
compatible cellular phone.
HINT:
• Confirm that either the same or a different version of
another Bluetooth compatible cellular phone complies
with the system.
• Depending on the version, some Bluetooth
compatible cellular phones cannot be used.
OK:
System functions.
NG
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLAY
OK
USE BLUETOOTH COMPATIBLE CELLULAR PHONE (DEPENDING ON THE VERSION)
3
CHECK USING ANOTHER BLUETOOTH CAPABLE VEHICLE
(a) Register the cellular phone with another vehicle and
check if the system functions normally.
HINT:
Depending on the version, some Bluetooth compatible
cellular phones cannot be used.
OK:
System functions.
OK
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLAY
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–111
NG
USE BLUETOOTH COMPATIBLE CELLULAR PHONE
4
CHECK CELLULAR PHONE
(a) Check if the cellular phone is Bluetooth compatible.
HINT:
Some versions of Bluetooth compatible cellular phones
may not function.
OK:
The phone is Bluetooth compatible.
NG
USE BLUETOOTH COMPATIBLE CELLULAR
PHONE
OK
5
CHECK CELLULAR PHONE
AV
(a) Check if a call can be made from the cellular phone.
HINT:
When the battery is low, registration or directory transfer
cannot be done.
OK:
A call can be made from the cellular phone.
NG
OK
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLAY
REPLACE CELLULAR PHONE
AV–112
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Cellular Phone cannot Send / Receive
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK BLUETOOTH SETTING
(a) Check if the Bluetooth settings are correct.
OK:
Bluetooth settings are correct.
NG
SET SETTINGS CORRECTLY
OK
2
CHECK CELLULAR PHONE
(a) Check if the cellular phone is Bluetooth compatible.
HINT:
Some versions of Bluetooth compatible cellular phones
may not function.
OK:
Phone is Bluetooth compatible.
AV
NG
END (ONLY A BLUETOOTH COMPATIBLE
CELLULAR PHONE CAN BE USED)
OK
3
CHECK SETTING
(a) Check if the cellular phone functions.
HINT:
The cellular phone is unable to call under any of the
following conditions.
• The cellular phone is locked.
• The directory is being transferred.
• The line is crossed.
• Transmission is regulated.
• The power is OFF.
• The cellular phone is not connected to Bluetooth
("Bluetooth mark" is displayed while connected).
OK:
Above conditions do not exist.
NG
SET CORRECTLY
OK
4
CHECK CELLULAR PHONE
(a) Check if the cellular phone can call.
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–113
HINT:
When the battery is low, calls cannot be made or
received.
OK:
Cellular phone can call.
NG
REPLACE CELLULAR PHONE
OK
5
CHECK RECEPTION
(a) Set the cellular phone so that it can receive calls.
(b) Place the cellular phone close to the multi-display.
(c) Check if the cellular phone has reception according to
the multi-display.
OK:
Cellular phone has reception.
NG
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLAY
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AV
AV–114
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Cannot Call in a Certain Place
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK SURROUNDING CONDITION
(a) Check if the cellular phone can make calls in a certain
location.
OK:
It can make calls.
NG
END (CELLULAR PHONES CAN ONLY
FUNCTION IN CELLULAR SERVICE AREAS)
OK
2
CHECK RECEPTION
(a) Enter the "Information" screen by pressing the "INFO"
switch.
(b) Select "Telephone".
AV
I102023
(c) Check the "BT" mark.
Result
I102024
Condition
Proceed to
Yellow color
A
Blue color
B
No connection mark is displayed
C
B
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLAY
C
SELECT REGISTERED CELLULAR PHONE
OR REGISTER BLUETOOTH COMPATIBLE
PHONE
A
BRING CELLULAR PHONE TO LOCATION WHERE BT MARK TURNS BLUE
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–115
The Other Caller's Voice cannot be Heard, is too Quiet, or Distorted
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CELLULAR PHONE
(a) Check if the voice on the other side can be heard using a
cellular phone.
OK:
Voice can be heard.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE CELLULAR PHONE
OK
2
CHECK SETTINGS
(a) Check if the volume level is low on the CALL screen.
OK:
The level is not low.
NG
SET VOLUME TO HIGH
I102027
OK
3
CHECK SETTINGS
E120069E02
(a) Enter the "Handsfree Voice Quality Set" mode (see page
AV-19).
(b) Check if the Receive Voice Level is set to "0".
HINT:
The Receive Voice Level can be set to 11 different
levels, -5 to +5, with a 3 dB difference.
(c) Check if the Receive Voice Level is set to the minimum
or maximum level.
HINT:
When the Receive Voice Level is set to the minimum or
maximum level, the sound may be distorted.
OK:
The Receive Voice Level is set to "0".
NG
SET RECEIVE VOICE LEVEL TO "0"
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AV
AV–116
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
The Other Caller cannot Hear Your Voice, or Your Voice is too Quiet or
Distorted
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CELLULAR PHONE
(a) Check if the other side can hear your voice properly.
OK:
Your voice can be heard correctly.
NG
REPLACE CELLULAR PHONE
OK
2
CHECK SETTINGS
(a) Check if the mute switch is set to ON.
OK:
Mute switch is not set to ON.
AV
NG
TURN MUTE SWITCH OFF
I102028
OK
3
CHECK SETTINGS
E120069E04
(a) Enter the "Handsfree Voice Quality Set" mode (see page
AV-19).
(b) Check if the Send Voice Level is set to "0".
HINT:
The Send Voice Level can be set to 11 different levels, -5
to +5, with a 3 dB difference.
(c) Check if the Send Voice Level is set to the minimum or
maximum level.
HINT:
When the Send Voice Level is set to the minimum or
maximum level, the sound may be distorted.
OK:
The Send Voice Level is set to "0".
NG
OK
SET SEND VOICE LEVEL TO "0"
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
4
AV–117
CHECK MICROPHONE (DISPLAY CHECK MODE)
Microphone Input Level Meter
Recording
Switch
Stop
Switch
Recording
Play
Switch Indicator
(a) Enter the "MICROPHONE & VOICE RECOGNITION
CHECK" mode (see page AV-16).
(b) When a voice is input into the microphone, check that
the microphone input level meter changes according to
the input voice.
(c) Push the recording switch and perform voice recording.
HINT:
The recording is limited to 5 seconds.
(d) Check that the recording indicator remains on while
recording and that the recorded voice is played normally
without noise or distortion.
OK:
All check results are normal.
NG
E125811E01
OK
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLAY
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION
PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM
SYMPTOMS TABLE
AV
AV–118
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Vehicle Speed Signal Circuit between Radio Receiver and Combination
Meter
DESCRIPTION
This circuit is necessary for the ASL (Auto Sound Levelizer) built into the radio receiver. Speed signals are
received from the combination meter and used for the ASL.
The ASL function automatically adjusts the sound data in order to enable hearing the clear audio even
when vehicle noise increases (as vehicle noise increases, the volume is turned up, etc.).
WIRING DIAGRAM
Combination Meter
Radio Receiver
SPD
E107202E04
AV
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
OPERATION OF SPEEDOMETER
(a) Drive the vehicle and check if the function of the
speedometer on the combination meter is normal.
OK:
Actual vehicle speed and the speed indicated on
the speedometer are the same.
HINT:
The vehicle speed sensor is functioning normally when
the indication on the speedometer is normal.
NG
GO TO METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
OK
2
CHECK RADIO RECEIVER (SPD VOLTAGE)
R5
SPD
E107234E01
(a) Disconnect the R5 receiver connector.
(b) Measure the voltage.
(1) Jack up either one of the drive wheels.
(2) Move the shift lever to the neutral position.
(3) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–119
(4) Measure the voltage between terminal SPD of the
radio receiver and body ground when the drive
wheels are turned slowly.
OK:
Voltage pulses as shown in the illustration.
OK
4.5 to 14 V
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
Below 2 V
0
Turn the wheel
E110855E01
NG
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (COMBINATION METER - RADIO RECEIVER)
(a) Disconnect the R5 receiver connector.
(b) Disconnect the C10 meter connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Radio Receiver
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
R5-3 (SPD) - C10-13
Below 1 Ω
R5
NG
SPD
Combination Meter
C10
E107206E01
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
AV
AV–120
4
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (RADIO RECEIVER - BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the R5 receiver connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
R5
SPD
E107195E03
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
R5-3 (SPD) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
HINT:
If the resistance between terminal SPD and body ground
is less than 10 kΩ, there may be a short in a wire
harness, connector, or an ECU that is connected to the
SPD signal wire.
NG
OK
AV
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
AV–121
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Steering Pad Switch Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This circuit sends an operation signal from the steering pad switch to the radio receiver.
If there is an open in the circuit, the audio system cannot be operated using the steering pad switch.
If there is a short in the circuit, the same condition as when the switch is continuously depressed occurs.
As a result, the radio receiver cannot be operated using the steering pad switch, and also the radio
receiver itself cannot function.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Steering Pad Switch
VOL-
VOL+
SEEK-
Spiral Cable
Radio Receiver
AU1
SW1
SEEK+
EAU
AV
SWG
MODE
AU2
ON
HOOK
OFF
HOOK
SW2
VOICE
E129490E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
The vehicle is equipped with an SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) which includes
components such as airbags. Before servicing (including removal or installation of parts), be sure
to read the precautionary notice for the Supplemental Restraint System.
AV–122
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
1
CHECK STEERING PAD SWITCH CIRCUIT
Wire Harness Side
Radio Receiver
SWG
SW1
SW2
R5
E107195E04
AV
(a) Disconnect the R5 receiver connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
R5-7 (SW1) - R5-6
(SWG)
No switch is pushed
Approx. 100 kΩ
R5-7 (SW1) - R5-6
(SWG)
SEEK+ switch is
pushed
Below 2.5 Ω
R5-7 (SW1) - R5-6
(SWG)
SEEK- switch is pushed
Approx. 320 Ω
R5-7 (SW1) - R5-6
(SWG)
VOL+ switch is pushed
Approx. 1 kΩ
R5-7 (SW1) - R5-6
(SWG)
VOL- switch is pushed
Approx. 3.2 kΩ
R5-8 (SW2) - R5-6
(SWG)
No switch is pushed
Approx. 100 kΩ
R5-8 (SW2) - R5-6
(SWG)
MODE switch is pushed
Below 2.5 Ω
R5-8 (SW2) - R5-6
(SWG)
VOICE switch is pushed
3,110 Ω
R5-8 (SW2) - R5-6
(SWG)
ON HOOK switch is
pushed
329 Ω
R5-8 (SW2) - R5-6
(SWG)
OFF HOOK switch is
pushed
1,000 Ω
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NG
2
INSPECT STEERING PAD SWITCH
VOL+ Switch
VOL- Switch
MODE Switch
VOICE Switch
SEEK+ Switch
SEEK- Switch
OFF HOOK Switch
EAC EAU
AU2
ON HOOK Switch
E126427E04
(a) Disconnect the steering pad switch connector.
AV–123
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
10 (AU1) - 8 (EAU)
No switch is pushed
Approx. 100 kΩ
10 (AU1) - 8 (EAU)
SEEK+ switch is
pushed
Below 2.5 Ω
10 (AU1) - 8 (EAU)
SEEK- switch is pushed
Approx. 320 Ω
10 (AU1) - 8 (EAU)
VOL+ switch is pushed
Approx. 1 kΩ
10 (AU1) - 8 (EAU)
VOL- switch is pushed
Approx. 3.2 kΩ
9 (AU2) - 8 (EAU)
No switch is pushed
Approx. 100 kΩ
9 (AU2) - 8 (EAU)
MODE switch is pushed
Below 2.5 Ω
9 (AU2) - 8 (EAU)
VOICE switch is pushed
3,110 Ω
9 (AU2) - 8 (EAU)
ON HOOK switch is
pushed
329 Ω
9 (AU2) - 8 (EAU)
OFF HOOK switch is
pushed
1,000 Ω
NG
REPLACE STEERING PAD SWITCH
OK
AV
3
INSPECT SPIRAL CABLE
(a) Disconnect the steering pad switch connector.
(b) Disconnect the spiral cable connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the cable.
Standard resistance
Steering Pad Switch Side
AU2
EAU
A
Tester connection
Spiral Cable Position
Specified condition
A-8 (EAU) - C12-4
(EAU)
Center
Below 1 Ω
AU1
2.5 rotations to the left
2.5 rotations to the right
A-10 (AU1) - C12-6
(AU1)
Center
Below 1 Ω
2.5 rotations to the left
2.5 rotations to the right
A-9 (AU2) - C12-5
(AU2)
Center
Below 1 Ω
2.5 rotations to the left
2.5 rotations to the right
Vehicle Side
C12
EAU
AU2
NOTICE:
The spiral cable is an important part of the SRS.
Incorrect removal or installation of the spiral cable
may prevent the airbag from deploying. Be sure to
read the SRS section's precaution.
NG
AU1
I039337E21
REPLACE SPIRAL CABLE
AV–124
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
OK
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SPIRAL CABLE - RADIO RECEIVER)
(a) Disconnect the R5 receiver connector.
(b) Disconnect the C12 cable connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Radio Receiver
SW2
R5
SWG
SW1
Spiral Cable
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
R5-7 (SW1) - C12-6 (AU1)
Below 1 Ω
R5-8 (SW2) - C12-5 (AU2)
Below 1 Ω
R5-6 (SWG) - C12-4 (EAU)
Below 1 Ω
R5-7 (SW1) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
R5-8 (SW2) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
R5-6 (SWG) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
C12
AV
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
AU1
EAU
AU2
E127904E04
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AV–125
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Illumination Circuit
DESCRIPTION
Power is supplied to the radio receiver, multi-display and steering pad switch illumination when the light
control switch is in the TAIL or HEAD position.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Multi-display
ILL+
ILL-
to Panel Fuse
Radio Receiver
ILL+
Steering Pad Switch
Spiral Cable
Illumination
ILL+
EAU
SWG
ILL-
E107196E04
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
The vehicle is equipped with an SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) which includes
components such as airbags. Before servicing (including removal or installation of parts), be sure
to read the precautionary notice for the supplemental restraint system.
AV
AV–126
1
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
CHECK ILLUMINATION
(a) Check if the illumination for the radio receiver, steering
pad switch, multi-display and other illuminations (hazard
switch, etc.) come on when the light control switch is
turned to the HEAD or TAIL position.
Result
Result
Proceed to
Illumination comes on for all components except steering pad switch.
A
Illumination comes on for all components except radio receiver.
B
Illumination comes on for all components except multi-display.
C
No illumination comes on (radio receiver, hazard switch, multi-display,
etc.).
D
B
Go to step 6
C
Go to step 7
D
AV
GO TO METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
A
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (BATTERY - SPIRAL CABLE)
(a) Disconnect the C12 cable connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
C12
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
C12-12 (ILL+) - Body
ground
Light control switch
TAIL or HEAD
10 to 14 V
NG
ILL+
OK
E126428E02
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
3
AV–127
INSPECT STEERING PAD SWITCH
ILL+
EAU
E129483E01
(a) Disconnect the steering pad switch connector.
(b) Connect the battery's positive (+) lead to terminal 5
(ILL+) and the negative (-) lead to terminal 8 (EAU) of the
steering pad switch connector.
(c) Check if the illumination for the steering pad switch
comes on.
OK:
Illumination for the steering pad switch comes on.
NG
OK
REPLACE STEERING PAD SWITCH
AV
AV–128
4
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
INSPECT SPIRAL CABLE
(a) Disconnect the steering pad switch connector.
(b) Disconnect the spiral cable connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the cable.
Standard resistance
Steering Pad Switch Side
EAU
ILL+
A
Tester Connection
Spiral Cable Position
Specified Condition
C12-4 (EAU) - A-8
(EAU)
Center
Below 1 Ω
2.5 rotations to the left
2.5 rotations to the right
C12-12 (ILL+) - A-5
(ILL+)
Center
Below 1 Ω
2.5 rotations to the left
2.5 rotations to the right
Vehicle Side
AV
NOTICE:
The spiral cable is an important part of the SRS.
Incorrect removal or installation of the spiral cable
may prevent the airbag from deploying. Be sure to
read the SRS section's precaution.
NG
C12
ILL+
EAU
I102015E09
OK
REPLACE SPIRAL CABLE
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
5
AV–129
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SPIRAL CABLE - RADIO RECEIVER)
(a) Disconnect the R5 receiver connector.
(b) Disconnect the C12 cable connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Radio Receiver
Tester Connection
R5
R5-6 (SWG) - C12-4 (EAU)
Below 1 Ω
R5-6 (SWG) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
SWG
Specified Condition
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
Spiral Cable
C12
AV
EAU
E127904E05
OK
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
AV–130
6
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (BATTERY - RADIO RECEIVER)
(a) Disconnect the R3*1 or R6*2 receiver connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
for 9 Speaker System
Radio Receiver
R6
ILL+
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
R3-10 (ILL+) - Body
ground*1
Light control switch
TAIL or HEAD
10 to 14 V
R6-2 (ILL+) - B0dy
ground*2
Light control switch
TAIL or HEAD
10 to 14 V
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
ILL-
for 6 Speaker System
Radio Receiver
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
R4-5 (ILL-) - Body ground*1
Below 1 Ω
R6-12 (ILL-) - Body ground*2
Below 1 Ω
HINT:
• *1: for 6 speaker system
• *2: for 9 speaker system
AV
NG
R3
ILL+
Radio Receiver
R4
ILL-
OK
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
E107193E03
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
AV–131
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
7
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (BATTERY - MULTI-DISPLAY)
(a) Disconnect the M13 display connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
ILL-*1
M13
ILL-*2
ILL+*2
ILL+*1
*1: for 3 Connector Type
*2: for 4 Connector Type
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
M13-1 (ILL+) - Body
ground*1
Light control switch
TAIL or HEAD
10 to 14 V
M13-12 (ILL+) - Body
ground*2
Light control switch
TAIL or HEAD
10 to 14 V
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
M13-2 (ILL-) - Body ground*1
Below 1 Ω
M13-11 (ILL-) - Body ground*2
Below 1 Ω
B118155E14
HINT:
• *1: for 3 connector type
• *2: for 4 connector type
NG
OK
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLAY
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
AV
AV–132
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Speaker Circuit
DESCRIPTION
• When the vehicle has a built-in type amplifier, a sound signal is sent from the radio receiver to the
speakers via the "6 Speaker System" circuit.
• When the vehicle has a separate type amplifier, a sound signal from the radio receiver is amplified by
the stereo component amplifier and then transmitted to the speaker via the "9 Speaker System".
If there is a short in this circuit, the stereo component amplifier detects it and stops output to the speakers.
Thus, sound cannot be heard from the speakers even if there is no malfunction in the stereo component
amplifier or speakers.
AV
AV–133
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
for 6 Speaker System
Radio Receiver
Front No. 2 Speaker LH
FL+
Front No. 1 Speaker LH
FL-
Front No. 2 Speaker RH
FR+
Front No. 1 Speaker RH
AV
FR-
RL+
Rear No. 1 Speaker LH
RL-
RR+
Rear No.1 Speaker RH
RR-
E107207E01
AV–134
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
for 9 Speaker System
Stereo Component Amplifier
FLFront No. 2 Speaker LH
FL+
FRFront No. 2 Speaker RH
AV
FR+
WFLFront No. 1 Speaker LH
WFL+
WFRFront No. 1 Speaker RH
WFR+
E107208E01
AV–135
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
CTRFront Stereo Component Speaker
CTR+
Rear No. 2 Speaker LH
RL-
AV
Rear No. 1 Speaker LH
RL+
Rear No. 2 Speaker RH
RRRear No. 1 Speaker RH
RR+
E107209E01
AV–136
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK VEHICLE EQUIPMENT
Vehicle equipment
Vehicle equipment
Proceed to
6 speaker system
A
9 speaker system
B
B
A
AV
Go to step 7
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
2
AV–137
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (RADIO RECEIVER - SPEAKER)
(a) Disconnect the R3 and R4 receiver connectors.
(b) Disconnect the T6, T7, R11 and R12 speaker
connectors.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Radio Receiver
FR+
R3
FL+
FR-
FL-
Radio Receiver
RR+
R4
RR-
RL+
RL-
*1
T7 *2
Rear No. 1 Speaker LH*1, RH*2
R11
*1
R12 *2
*1: for LH
*2: for RH
E107212E03
OK
Specified Condition
R3-2 (FL+) - T6-4
Below 1 Ω
R3-6 (FL-) - T6-2
Below 1 Ω
R3-1 (FR+) - T7-4
Below 1 Ω
R3-5 (FR-) - T7-2
Below 1 Ω
R4-2 (RL+) - R11-1
Below 1 Ω
R4-6 (RL-) - R11-2
Below 1 Ω
R4-1 (RR+) - R12-1
Below 1 Ω
R4-3 (RR-) - R12-2
Below 1 Ω
NG
Front No. 2 Speaker LH*1, RH*2
T6
Tester Connection
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
AV
AV–138
3
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (FRONT NO. 1 SPEAKER - FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER)
(a) Disconnect the F12, F13, T6 and T7 speaker
connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Front No. 1 Speaker LH*1, RH*2
F12 *1
F13 *2
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
F12-1 - T6-3
Below 1 Ω
F12-2 - T6-1
Below 1 Ω
F13-1 - T7-3
Below 1 Ω
F13-2 - T7-1
Below 1 Ω
NG
Front No. 2 Speaker LH*1, RH*2
T6 *1
T7 *2
AV
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
*1: for LH
*2: for RH
E107213E04
OK
4
INSPECT FRONT NO. 1 SPEAKER
(a) Disconnect the F12 and F13 speaker connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance of the speaker.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1-2
Approximately 4 Ω
NG
REPLACE FRONT NO. 1 SPEAKER
E107214
OK
5
INSPECT FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER
(a) Check that the malfunction disappears when the speaker
is replaced with a normal one.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
HINT:
• Connect all the connectors to the front No. 2
speakers.
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–139
• When there is a possibility that either the right or left
front speaker is defective, inspect by interchanging
the right one with the left one.
• Perform the inspection above on both LH and RH
sides.
NG
REPLACE FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER
OK
6
INSPECT REAR NO. 1 SPEAKER
(a) Disconnect the R11 and R12 speaker connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance of the speaker.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1-2
Approximately 4 Ω
NG
E107214
OK
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
REPLACE REAR NO. 1 SPEAKER
AV
AV–140
7
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER - SPEAKER)
(a) Disconnect the S14 and S29 amplifier connectors.
(b) Disconnect the C8, F12, F13, T6, T7, T8 and T9 speaker
connectors.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Stereo Component Amplifier
RL+
FR+
S14
FR- FL-
FL+
RR-
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S29-2 (WFL+) - F12-1
Below 1 Ω
RR+
S29-1 (WFL-) - F12-2
Below 1 Ω
RL-
Stereo Component Amplifier
S29
CTR+
WFL-
AV
WFL+
WFR- WFR+
CTR-
Front No. 1 Speaker LH*1, RH*2
S29-9 (WFR+) - F13-1
Below 1 Ω
S29-3 (WFR-) - F13-2
Below 1 Ω
S14-8 (FL+) - T6-4
Below 1 Ω
S14-7 (FL-) - T6-2
Below 1 Ω
S14-2 (FR+) - T7-4
Below 1 Ω
S14-6 (FR-) - T7-2
Below 1 Ω
S14-3 (RL+) - T8-4
Below 1 Ω
S14-9 (RL-) - T8-2
Below 1 Ω
S14-10 (RR+) - T9-4
Below 1 Ω
S14-4 (RR-) - T9-2
Below 1 Ω
S29-4 (CTR+) - C8-2
Below 1 Ω
S29-10 (CTR-) - C8-1
Below 1 Ω
NG
F12 *1
F13 *2
Front No. 2 Speaker LH*1, RH*2
Rear No. 2 Speaker LH*3, RH*4
T6 *1
T7 *2
T8 *3
T9 *4
Front Stereo Component Speaker
C8
E107215E03
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–141
OK
8
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (REAR NO. 1 SPEAKER - REAR NO. 2 SPEAKER)
(a) Disconnect the R11, R12, T8 and T9 speaker
connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Rear No. 1 Speaker LH*1, RH*2
R11 *1
R12 *2
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
R11-1 - T8-3
Below 1 Ω
R11-2 - T8-1
Below 1 Ω
R12-1 - T9-3
Below 1 Ω
R12-2 - T9-1
Below 1 Ω
NG
Rear No. 2 Speaker LH*1, RH*2
T8 *1
*2
T9
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
AV
*1: for LH
*2: for RH
E107213E05
OK
9
INSPECT FRONT NO. 1 SPEAKER
(a) Disconnect the F12 and F13 speaker connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance of the speaker.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1-2
Approximately 4 Ω
NG
REPLACE FRONT NO. 1 SPEAKER
E107214
OK
10
INSPECT FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER
(a) Check that the malfunction disappears when the speaker
is replaced with a normal one.
OK :
Malfunction disappears
HINT:
• Connect all the connectors to the front No. 2
speakers.
AV–142
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
• When there is a possibility that either the right or left
front speaker is defective, inspect by interchanging
the right one with the left one.
• Perform the inspection above on both LH and RH
sides.
NG
REPLACE FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER
OK
11
INSPECT REAR NO. 1 SPEAKER
(a) Disconnect the R11 and R12 speaker connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance of the speaker.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1-2
Approximately 4 Ω
NG
AV
REPLACE REAR NO. 1 SPEAKER
E107214
OK
12
INSPECT REAR NO. 2 SPEAKER
(a) Check that the malfunction disappears when the speaker
is replaced with a normal one.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
HINT:
• Connect all the connectors to the rear No. 2 speakers.
• When there is a possibility that either the right or left
rear speaker is defective, inspect by interchanging the
right one with the left one.
• Perform the inspection above on both LH or RH sides.
NG
OK
REPLACE REAR NO. 2 SPEAKER
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
13
AV–143
INSPECT FRONT STEREO COMPONENT SPEAKER
(a) Disconnect the C8 speaker connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the speaker.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1-2
1.2 to 2.2 Ω
NG
REPLACE FRONT STEREO COMPONENT
SPEAKER
E116557
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AV
AV–144
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Sound Signal Circuit between Radio Receiver and Stereo Component
Amplifier
DESCRIPTION
The radio receiver sends a sound signal to the stereo component amplifier through this circuit.
The sound signal that has been sent is amplified by the stereo component amplifier, and then is sent to
the speakers.
If there is an open or short in the circuit, sound cannot be heard from the speakers even if there is no
malfunction in the stereo component amplifier or speakers.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Stereo Component Amplifier
Radio Receiver
Shielded
SLD
AV
L-
L-
L+
L+
R-
R-
R+
R+
E107198E01
AV–145
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (RADIO RECEIVER - STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER)
(a) Disconnect the R6 receiver connector.
(b) Disconnect the S15 amplifier connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Radio Receiver
R+
L+
R6
SLD
R-
L-
Stereo Component Amplifier
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
R6-9 (L+) - S15-3 (L+)
Below 1 Ω
R6-19 (L-) - S15-2 (L-)
Below 1 Ω
R6-8 (R+) - S15-5 (R+)
Below 1 Ω
R6-18 (R-) - S15-4 (R-)
Below 1 Ω
R6-9 (L+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
R6-19 (L-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
R6-8 (R+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
R6-18 (R-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
R6-10 (SLD) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S15
NG
L-
L+ R- R+
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
E107199E01
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AV
AV–146
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Sound Signal Circuit between Radio Receiver and Stereo Jack Adapter
DESCRIPTION
The stereo jack adapter sends an external device sound signal to the radio receiver through this circuit.
The sound signal that has been sent is amplified by the stereo component amplifier, and then is sent to
the speakers.
If there is an open or short in the circuit, sound cannot be heard from the speakers even if there is no
malfunction in the stereo component amplifier, radio receiver, or speakers.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Stereo Jack Adapter
Radio Receiver
AUXI
AUXO
AV
Shielded
ASGN
Shielded
ASGN
ARO
ARI
ALO
ALI
E107216E01
AV–147
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (RADIO RECEIVER - STEREO JACK ADAPTER)
(a) Disconnect the R5 receiver connector.
(b) Disconnect the S30 adapter connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Radio Receiver
Tester Connection
R5
ARI ASGN ALI AUXI
Stereo Jack Adapter
S30
Specified Condition
S30-4 (AUXO) - R5-19 (AUXI)
Below 1 Ω
S30-3 (ASGN) - R5-16 (ASGN)
Below 1 Ω
S30-2 (ARO) - R5-15 (ARI)
Below 1 Ω
S30-1 (ALO) - R5-17 (ALI)
Below 1 Ω
S30-4 (AUXO) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S30-3 (ASGN) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S30-2 (ARO) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S30-1 (ALO) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
ALO ARO ASGN AUXO
E107217E02
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AV
AV–148
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Mute Signal Circuit between Radio Receiver and Stereo Component
Amplifier
DESCRIPTION
This circuit sends a signal to the stereo component amplifier to mute noise. As a reslut, the noise
produced by changing the sound source ceases.
If there is an open in the circuit, noise can be heard from the speakers when changing the sound source.
If there is a short in the circuit, even though the stereo component amplifier is normal, no sound, or only
an extremely small sound can be produced.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Stereo Component Amplifier
Radio Receiver
MUTE
MUTE
AV
E107202E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER (MUTE VOLTAGE)
S15
(a) Measure the voltage of the amplifier.
Standard voltage
MUTE
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
S15-1 (MUTE) - Body
ground
Turn power switch ON
(ACC), Audio system is
playing → Changing
mode
Above 3.5 V → Below 1
V
OK
E107229E01
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
2
AV–149
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (RADIO RECEIVER - STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER)
(a) Disconnect the R6 receiver connector.
(b) Disconnect the S15 amplifier connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Radio Receiver
Tester Connection
R6
Specified Condition
R6-7 (MUTE) - S15-1 (MUTE)
Below 1 Ω
R6-7 (MUTE) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
MUTE
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
Stereo Component Amplifier
S15
AV
MUTE
E107199E02
OK
3
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
(a) Replace the radio receiver with a normal one and check
if it operates normally.
OK:
The radio receiver operates normally.
NG
OK
END
REPLACE STEREO COMPONENT
AMPLIFIER
AV–150
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AVC-LAN Circuit
DESCRIPTION
Each unit of the audio system connected to the AVC-LAN (communication bus) transfers the signal of
each switch by communication.
When a short to +B or short to ground occurs in this AVC-LAN, the audio system will not function normally
as the communication is discontinued.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT RADIO RECEIVER
(a) for 9 Speaker System:
Disconnect the R5 and R6 receiver connectors.
(b) for 6 Speaker System:
Disconnect the R5 receiver connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the receiver.
Standard resistance
for 9 Speaker System
Radio Receiver
TX+
AV
R5
TX-
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
R5-9 (TX1+) - R5-10 (TX1-)*1
60 to 80 Ω
R5-9 (TX+) - R5-10 (TX-)*2
60 to 80 Ω
R6-5 (TX+) - R6-15 (TX-)*2
60 to 80 Ω
HINT:
• *1: for 6 speaker system
• *2: for 9 speaker system
Radio Receiver
NG
R6
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
TX+
TXfor 6 Speaker System
TX1+
Radio Receiver
R5
TX1E107228E01
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS
HINT:
For details of the connectors, refer to the "TERMINALS OF
ECU" (see page AV-31).
AV–151
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
(a) Referring to the AVC-LAN wiring diagram below, check
all AVC-LAN circuits.
(1) Disconnect all connectors in all AVC-LAN circuits.
(2) Check for an open or short in all AVC-LAN circuits.
OK:
There is no open or short circuit.
AVC-LAN Wiring Diagram
Multi-display
Gateway ECU
GTX+
Slave Unit
TX1+
Radio Receiver
TX1+*1
TX+*2
TX2+
Master Unit
GTX-
TX1-
TX1-*1
TX-*2
TX2-
AV
Slave Unit
Stereo Component Amplifier*2
TX+*2
*1: for 6 Speaker System
Slave Unit
TX-*2
*2: for 9 Speaker System
*2
*2
TX+*2
TX-*2
E126611E01
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AV–152
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Vehicle Speed Signal Circuit between Stereo Component Amplifier and
Combination Meter
DESCRIPTION
This circuit is necessary for the ASL (Auto Sound Levelizer) built into the stereo component amplifier.
Speed signals are received from the combination meter and used for the ASL.
The ASL function automatically adjusts the sound data in order to enable hearing the clear audio even
when vehicle noise increases (as vehicle noise increases, the volume is turned up, etc.).
WIRING DIAGRAM
Combination Meter
Stereo Component Amplifier
SPD
E107202E03
AV
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK OPERATION OF SPEEDOMETER
(a) Drive the vehicle and check if the function of the
speedometer on the combination meter is normal.
OK:
Actual vehicle speed and the speed indicated on
the speedometer are the same.
HINT:
The vehicle speed sensor is functioning normally when
the indication on the speedometer is normal.
NG
GO TO METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
OK
2
CHECK STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER
SPD
(a) Disconnect the S15 amplifier connector.
(b) Measure the voltage.
(1) Jack up either one of the drive wheels.
(2) Move the shift lever to the neutral position.
(3) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
S15
E107229E02
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–153
(4) Measure the voltage between terminal 11 (SPD) of
the stereo component amplifier and body ground
when the drive wheels are turned slowly.
OK:
Voltage pulses as shown in the illustration.
OK
4.5 to 14 V
REPLACE STEREO COMPONENT
AMPLIFIER
Below 2 V
0
Turn the wheel
E110855E01
NG
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (COMBINATION METER - STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER)
(a) Disconnect the S15 amplifier connector.
(b) Disconnect the C10 meter connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Stereo Component Amplifier
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S15-11 (SPD) - C10-13
Below 1 Ω
S15
NG
SPD
Combination Meter
C10
E107205E02
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
AV
AV–154
4
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER - BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the S15 amplifier connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
S15
SPD
E107203E04
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S15-11 (SPD) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
HINT:
If the resistance between terminal 11 (SPD) and body
ground is less than 10 kΩ, there may be a short in a wire
harness, connector, or an ECU that is connected to the
SPD signal wire.
NG
OK
AV
REPLACE STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
AV–155
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Microphone Circuit between Overhead J/B and Multi-display
DESCRIPTION
This circuit sends a microphone signal from the microphone to the multi-display. It also supplies power
from multi-display to the microphone.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Overhead Junction Block
Microphone
Multi-display
ACC
MACC
MI1+
MIN+
MIC-
MINShielded
AV
Shielded
E130117E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK MULTI-DISPLAY (MACC VOLTAGE)
M14
MACC
(a) Measure the voltage of the display.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
M14-4 (MACC) - Body
ground
Power switch ON (ACC)
10 to 14 V
NG
E129491E01
OK
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLAY
AV–156
2
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (MULTI-DISPLAY - OVERHEAD JUNCTION BLOCK)
(a) Disconnect the M14 display connector.
(b) Disconnect the O3 junction block connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Multi-display
M14
Tester Connection
MIN+
MIN-
MACC
Overhead Junction Block
Specified Condition
M14-4 (MACC) - O3-7 (ACC)
Below 1 Ω
M14-2 (MIN+) - O3-8 (MI1+)
Below 1 Ω
M14-3 (MIN-) - O3-9 (MIC-)
Below 1 Ω
M14-4 (MACC) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
M14-2 (MIN+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
M14-3 (MIN-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
O3
AV
ACC
MI1+
MIC-
E126436E03
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–157
Gateway ECU Communication Error
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
IDENTIFY COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE
(a) Enter the diagnostic mode.
(b) Press the "LAN Mon" switch to change to "LAN Monitor"
mode.
(c) Identify the component which has stored this code.
HINT:
• "110 (multi-display)" is the component shown by the
sub-code in the example shown in the illustration.
• The sub-code will be indicated by its physical
address.
• For details of the DTC display, refer to "DIAGNOSIS
DISPLAY DETAILED DESCRIPTION" (see page AV22).
Example
AV
Component which
has stored this code
DTC
Component shown by sub-code
E107226E01
NEXT
2
CHECK POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT OF COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE
(a) Inspect the power source circuit of the component shown
by the sub-code.
If the power source circuit is operating normally, proceed
to the next step.
Component table:
Component
Proceed to
Multi-display (110)
Multi-display power source circuit (see page AV-175)
Stereo component amplifier (440)
Stereo component amplifier power source circuit (see page AV-173)
AV–158
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Component
Proceed to
Radio receiver (190)
Radio receiver power source circuit (see page AV-171)
NEXT
3
INSPECT RADIO RECEIVER
(a) for 9 Speaker System:
Disconnect the R5 and R6 receiver connectors.
(b) for 6 Speaker System:
Disconnect the R5 receiver connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the receiver.
Standard resistance
for 9 Speaker System
Radio Receiver
TX+
R5
TX-
Specified Condition
R5-9 (TX1+) - R5-10 (TX1-)*1
60 to 80 Ω
R5-9 (TX+) - R5-10 (TX-)*2
60 to 80 Ω
R6-5 (TX+) - R6-15 (TX-)*2
60 to 80 Ω
HINT:
• *1: for 6 speaker system
• *2: for 9 speaker system
Radio Receiver
AV
Tester Connection
NG
R6
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
TX+
TXfor 6 Speaker System
TX1+
Radio Receiver
R5
TX1E107228E01
OK
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (GATEWAY ECU - COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE)
HINT:
• Start the check from the circuit that is near the component
shown by the sub-code first.
• For details of the connectors, refer to the "TERMINALS OF
ECU" (see page AV-31).
(a) Referring to the AVC-LAN wiring diagram below, check
the AVC-LAN circuit between the gateway ECU and the
component shown by the sub-code.
AV–159
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
(1) Disconnect all connectors between the gateway
ECU and the component shown by sub-code.
(2) Check for an open or short in the AVC-LAN circuit
between the gateway ECU and the component
shown by the sub-code.
OK:
There is no open or short circuit.
AVC-LAN Wiring Diagram
Multi-display
Gateway ECU
GTX+
Slave Unit
TX1+
Radio Receiver
TX1+*1
TX+*2
TX2+
Master Unit
GTX-
TX1-
TX1-*1
TX-*2
TX2-
AV
Slave Unit
Stereo Component Amplifier*2
TX+*2
*1: for 6 Speaker System
Slave Unit
TX-*2
*2: for 9 Speaker System
*2
*2
TX+*2
TX-*2
E126611E01
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
5
REPLACE COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE
(a) Replace the component shown by the sub-code with a
normal one and check if the same problem occurs again.
OK:
Same problem does not occur.
NG
REPLACE GATEWAY ECU
AV–160
OK
END
AV
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–161
Radio Receiver Communication Error
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
IDENTIFY COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE
(a) Enter the diagnostic mode.
(b) Press the "LAN Mon" switch to change to "LAN Monitor"
mode.
(c) Identify the component which has stored this code.
HINT:
• "110 (multi-display)" is the component shown by the
sub-code in the example shown in the illustration.
• The sub-code will be indicated by its physical
address.
• For details of the DTC display, refer to "DIAGNOSIS
DISPLAY DETAILED DESCRIPTION" (see page AV22).
Example
AV
Component which
has stored this code
DTC
Component shown by sub-code
E107226E01
NEXT
2
CHECK POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT OF COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE
(a) Inspect the power source circuit of the component shown
by the sub-code.
If the power source circuit is operating normally, proceed
to the next step.
Component table:
Component
Proceed to
Gateway ECU (1C6)
Gateway ECU power source circuit (see page AV-177)
Stereo component amplifier (440)
Stereo component amplifier power source circuit (see page AV-173)
AV–162
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Component
Proceed to
Multi-display (110)
Multi-display power source circuit (see page AV-175)
NEXT
3
INSPECT RADIO RECEIVER
(a) for 9 Speaker System:
Disconnect the R5 and R6 receiver connectors.
(b) for 6 Speaker System:
Disconnect the R5 receiver connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the receiver.
Standard resistance
for 9 Speaker System
Radio Receiver
TX+
R5
TX-
Specified Condition
R5-9 (TX1+) - R5-10 (TX1-)*1
60 to 80 Ω
R5-9 (TX+) - R5-10 (TX-)*2
60 to 80 Ω
R6-5 (TX+) - R6-15 (TX-)*2
60 to 80 Ω
HINT:
• *1: for 6 speaker system
• *2: for 9 speaker system
Radio Receiver
AV
Tester Connection
NG
R6
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
TX+
TXfor 6 Speaker System
TX1+
Radio Receiver
R5
TX1E107228E01
OK
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (RADIO RECEIVER - COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE)
HINT:
• Start the check from the circuit that is near the component
shown by the sub-code first.
• For details of the connectors, refer to the "TERMINALS OF
ECU" (see page AV-31).
(a) Referring to the AVC-LAN wiring diagram below, check
the AVC-LAN circuit between the radio receiver and the
component shown by the sub-code.
AV–163
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
(1) Disconnect all connectors between the radio
receiver and the component shown by sub-code.
(2) Check for an open or short in the AVC-LAN circuit
between the radio receiver and the component
shown by the sub-code.
OK:
There is no open or short circuit.
AVC-LAN Wiring Diagram
Multi-display
Gateway ECU
GTX+
Slave Unit
TX1+
Radio Receiver
TX1+*1
TX+*2
TX2+
Master Unit
GTX-
TX1-
TX1-*1
TX-*2
TX2-
AV
Slave Unit
Stereo Component Amplifier*2
TX+*2
*1: for 6 Speaker System
Slave Unit
TX-*2
*2: for 9 Speaker System
*2
*2
TX+*2
TX-*2
E126611E01
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
5
REPLACE COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE
(a) Replace the component shown by the sub-code with a
normal one and check if the same problem occurs again.
OK:
Same problem does not occur.
NG
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
AV–164
OK
END
AV
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–165
Stereo Component Amplifier Communication Error
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
IDENTIFY COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE
(a) Enter the diagnostic mode.
(b) Press the "LAN Mon" switch to change to "LAN Monitor"
mode.
(c) Identify the component which has stored this code.
HINT:
• "110 (multi-display)" is the component shown by the
sub-code in the example shown in the illustration.
• The sub-code will be indicated by its physical
address.
• For details of the DTC display, refer to "DIAGNOSIS
DISPLAY DETAILED DESCRIPTION" (see page AV22).
Example
AV
Component which
has stored this code
DTC
Component shown by sub-code
E107226E01
NEXT
2
CHECK POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT OF COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE
(a) Inspect the power source circuit of the component shown
by the sub-code.
If the power source circuit is operating normally, proceed
to the next step.
Component table:
Component
Proceed to
Gateway ECU (1C6)
Gateway ECU power source circuit (see page AV-177)
Multi-display (110)
Multi-display power source circuit (see page AV-175)
AV–166
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Component
Proceed to
Radio receiver (190)
Radio receiver power source circuit (see page AV-171)
NEXT
3
INSPECT RADIO RECEIVER
(a) for 9 Speaker System:
Disconnect the R5 and R6 receiver connectors.
(b) for 6 Speaker System:
Disconnect the R5 receiver connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the receiver.
Standard resistance
for 9 Speaker System
Radio Receiver
TX+
R5
TX-
Specified Condition
R5-9 (TX1+) - R5-10 (TX1-)*1
60 to 80 Ω
R5-9 (TX+) - R5-10 (TX-)*2
60 to 80 Ω
R6-5 (TX+) - R6-15 (TX-)*2
60 to 80 Ω
HINT:
• *1: for 6 speaker system
• *2: for 9 speaker system
Radio Receiver
AV
Tester Connection
NG
R6
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
TX+
TXfor 6 Speaker System
TX1+
Radio Receiver
R5
TX1E107228E01
OK
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER - COMPONENT SHOWN BY
SUB-CODE)
HINT:
• Start the check from the circuit that is near the component
shown by the sub-code first.
• For details of the connectors, refer to the "TERMINALS OF
ECU" (see page AV-31).
(a) Referring to the AVC-LAN wiring diagram below, check
the AVC-LAN circuit between the stereo component
amplifier and the component shown by the sub-code.
AV–167
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
(1) Disconnect all connectors between the stereo
component amplifier and the component shown by
sub-code.
(2) Check for an open or short in the AVC-LAN circuit
between the stereo component amplifier and the
component shown by the sub-code.
OK:
There is no open or short circuit.
AVC-LAN Wiring Diagram
Multi-display
Gateway ECU
GTX+
Slave Unit
TX1+
Radio Receiver
TX1+*1
TX+*2
TX2+
Master Unit
GTX-
TX1-
TX1-*1
TX-*2
TX2-
AV
Slave Unit
Stereo Component Amplifier*2
TX+*2
*1: for 6 Speaker System
Slave Unit
TX-*2
*2: for 9 Speaker System
*2
*2
TX+*2
TX-*2
E126611E01
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
5
REPLACE COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE
(a) Replace the component shown by the sub-code with a
normal one and check if the same problem occurs again.
OK:
Same problem does not occur.
AV–168
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
NG
OK
END
AV
REPLACE STEREO COMPONENT
AMPLIFIER
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–169
Multi-display Communication Error
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
IDENTIFY COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE
(a) Enter the diagnostic mode.
(b) Press the "LAN Mon" switch to change to "LAN Monitor"
mode.
(c) Identify the component which has stored this code.
HINT:
• "110 (multi-display)" is the component shown by the
sub-code in the example shown in the illustration.
• The sub-code will be indicated by its physical
address.
• For details of the DTC display, refer to "DIAGNOSIS
DISPLAY DETAILED DESCRIPTION" (see page AV22).
Example
AV
Component which
has stored this code
DTC
Component shown by sub-code
E107226E01
NEXT
2
CHECK POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT OF COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE
(a) Inspect the power source circuit of the component shown
by the sub-code.
If the power source circuit is operating normally, proceed
to the next step.
Component table:
Component
Proceed to
Gateway ECU (1C6)
Gateway ECU power source circuit (see page AV-177)
Stereo component amplifier (440)
Stereo component amplifier power source circuit (see page AV-173)
AV–170
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Component
Proceed to
Radio Receiver (190)
Radio receiver power source circuit (see page AV-171)
NEXT
3
INSPECT RADIO RECEIVER
(a) for 9 Speaker System:
Disconnect the R5 and R6 receiver connectors.
(b) for 6 Speaker System:
Disconnect the R5 receiver connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the receiver.
Standard resistance
for 9 Speaker System
Radio Receiver
TX+
R5
TX-
Specified Condition
R5-9 (TX1+) - R5-10 (TX1-)*1
60 to 80 Ω
R5-9 (TX+) - R5-10 (TX-)*2
60 to 80 Ω
R6-5 (TX+) - R6-15 (TX-)*2
60 to 80 Ω
HINT:
• *1: for 6 speaker system
• *2: for 9 speaker system
Radio Receiver
AV
Tester Connection
NG
R6
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER
TX+
TXfor 6 Speaker System
TX1+
Radio Receiver
R5
TX1E107228E01
OK
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (MULTI-DISPLAY - COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE)
HINT:
• Start the check from the circuit that is near the component
shown by the sub-code first.
• For details of the connectors, refer to the "TERMINALS OF
ECU" (see page AV-31).
(a) Referring to the AVC-LAN wiring diagram below, check
the AVC-LAN circuit between the multi-display and the
component shown by the sub-code.
AV–171
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
(1) Disconnect all connectors between the multi-display
and the component shown by sub-code.
(2) Check for an open or short in the AVC-LAN circuit
between the multi-display and the component
shown by the sub-code.
OK:
There is no open or short circuit.
AVC-LAN Wiring Diagram
Multi-display
Gateway ECU
GTX+
Slave Unit
TX1+
Radio Receiver
TX1+*1
TX+*2
TX2+
Master Unit
GTX-
TX1-
TX1-*1
TX-*2
TX2-
AV
Slave Unit
Stereo Component Amplifier*2
TX+*2
*1: for 6 Speaker System
Slave Unit
TX-*2
*2: for 9 Speaker System
*2
*2
TX+*2
TX-*2
E126611E01
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
5
REPLACE COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE
(a) Replace the component shown by the sub-code with a
normal one and check if the same problem occurs again.
OK:
Same problem does not occur.
NG
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLAY
AV–172
OK
END
AV
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
AV–173
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Radio Receiver Power Source Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This circuit provides power to the radio receiver.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Radio Receiver
from Battery
DOME
+B
AV
from ACC Relay
ACC
ACC
GND
E107218E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT FUSE (DOME, ACC)
(a) Disconnect the DOME fuse from the engine room
junction block.
AV–174
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
(b) Disconnect the ACC fuse from the driver side junction
block.
(c) Measure the resistance of the fuses.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE FUSE
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (RECEIVER - BATTERY AND BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the R3*1 or R6*2 receiver connector.
HINT:
• *1: for 6 speaker system
• *2: for 9 speaker system
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
for 9 Speaker System
Radio Receiver
R6
+B
AV
GND
ACC
Specified Condition
R3-7 (GND) - Body ground*1
Below 1 Ω
R6-20 (GND) - Body ground*2
(c) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
for 6 Speaker System
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
ACC
R3-4 (+B) - R3-7
(GND)*1
Always
10 to 14 V
+B
R6-1 (+B) - R6-20
(GND)*2
Power switch ON (ACC)
10 to 14 V
Radio Receiver
R3
Tester Connection
R3-3 (ACC) - R3-7
(GND)*1
GND
E129162E01
R6-11 (ACC) - R6-20
(GND)*2
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AV–175
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Stereo Component Amplifier Power Source Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This circuit provides power to the stereo component amplifier.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Stereo Component Amplifier
from Battery
AMP
+B
+B2
from ACC Relay
ACC
AV
ACC
GND
GND2
E107219E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT FUSE (AMP, ACC)
(a) Disconnect the AMP fuse from the engine room junction
block.
AV–176
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
(b) Disconnect the ACC fuse from the driver side junction
block.
(c) Measure the resistance of the fuses.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE FUSE
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (AMPLIFIER - BATTERY AND BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the S14, S15 and S29 amplifier connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Stereo Component Amplifier
+B
S14
AV
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S29-6 (GND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
S29-7 (GND2) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
(c) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard voltage
+B2
Stereo Component Amplifier
ACC
S15
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
S14-1 (+B) - S29-6
(GND)
Always
10 to 14 V
S14-5 (+B2) - S29-6
(GND)
Always
10 to 14 V
S15-12 (ACC) - S29-6
(GND)
Power switch ON (ACC)
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
Stereo Component Amplifier
S29
GND
GND2
E107220E02
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AV–177
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Multi-display Power Source Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This circuit provides power to the multi-display.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Multi-display
from Battery
ECU-B
+B1
AV
from ACC Relay
ACC
ACC
GND*1
GND1*2
*1: for 4 Connector Type
*2: for 3 Connector Type
E107218E04
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT FUSE (ECU-B, ACC)
(a) Disconnect the ECU-B and ACC fuses from the driver
side junction block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the fuses.
AV–178
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE FUSE
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (MULTI-DISPLAY - BATTERY AND BODY GROUND)
Wire Harness Side
ACC*1
GND*1
+B1*1
ACC*2
GND1*2
B1*2
M13
AV
(a) Disconnect the M13 connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
M13-1 (GND) - Body ground*1
Below 1 Ω
M13-3 (GND1) - Body ground*2
Below 1 Ω
(c) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
*1: for 4 Connector Type
M13-2 (ACC) - Body
ground*1
Power switch ON (ACC)
10 to 14 V
*2: for 3 Connector Type
M13-3 (+B1) - Body
ground*1
Always
10 to 14 V
M13-11 (ACC) - Body
ground*2
Power switch ON (ACC)
10 to 14 V
M13-12 (B1) - Body
ground*2
Always
10 to 14 V
B118155E15
HINT:
• *1: for 4 Connector type
• *2: for 3 Connector type
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AV–179
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Gateway ECU Power Source Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This is the power source circuit to operate the gateway ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Gateway ECU
ECU-IG
from IG1 Relay
ACC
from ACC Relay
ECU-B
from Battery
IG
AV
ACC
BATT
GND
E107221E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT FUSE (ECU-IG, ACC, ECU-B)
(a) Disconnect the ECU-IG, ECU-B and ACC fuses from the
driver side junction block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the fuses.
AV–180
AUDIO / VISUAL – AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE FUSE
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (GATEWAY ECU - BATTERY AND BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the G1 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
ACC
G1
IG
BATT
GND
E107222E02
AV
Tester connection
Specified condition
G1-24 (GND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
(c) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
G1-10 (BATT) - G1-24
(GND)
Always
10 to 14 V
G1-2 (ACC) - G1-24
(GND)
Power switch ON (ACC)
10 to 14 V
G1-1 (IG) - G1-24 (GND)
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
AV–179
AUDIO / VISUAL – RADIO RECEIVER
RADIO RECEIVER
BODY ELECTRICAL
AUDIO
/ VISUAL
COMPONENTS
AV
MULTI-DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
RADIO RECEIVER ASSEMBLY
NO. 3 INSTRUMENT PANEL
REGISTER ASSEMBLY
NO. 4 INSTRUMENT PANEL
REGISTER ASSEMBLY
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL ASSEMBLY CENTER
B139837E01
AV–180
AUDIO / VISUAL – RADIO RECEIVER
RADIO RECEIVER ASSEMBLY
NO. 1 RADIO BRACKET
NO. 2 RADIO BRACKET
AV
STEREO OPENING COVER
B139836E01
AUDIO / VISUAL – RADIO RECEIVER
AV–181
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE NO. 3 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-6)
3.
REMOVE NO. 4 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-6)
4.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL
ASSEMBLY CENTER (See page IP-18)
5.
REMOVE MULTI-DISPLAY ASSEMBLY (See page NS172)
6.
REMOVE RADIO RECEIVER WITH BRACKET
(a) Remove the 4 screws.
(b) Disconnect the connector and remove the radio
receiver w/ bracket.
I038866E01
7.
I038867E01
REMOVE NO. 1 RADIO BRACKET
(a) Remove the 6 screws and No. 1 radio bracket.
AV
AV–182
AUDIO / VISUAL – RADIO RECEIVER
8.
REMOVE NO. 2 RADIO BRACKET
(a) Remove the 6 screws and No. 2 radio bracket.
I038868E01
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL NO. 2 RADIO BRACKET
(a) Install the No. 2 radio bracket to the radio receiver
with the 6 screws.
2.
INSTALL NO. 1 RADIO BRACKET
(a) Install the No. 1 radio bracket to the radio receiver
with the 6 screws.
I038868E01
AV
I038867E01
AUDIO / VISUAL – RADIO RECEIVER
I038866E01
AV–183
3.
INSTALL RADIO RECEIVER WITH BRACKET
(a) Connect all the connectors and install the radio
receiver.
(b) Install the 4 screws.
4.
INSTALL MULTI-DISPLAY ASSEMBLY (See page NS172)
5.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL
ASSEMBLY CENTER (See page IP-22)
6.
INSTALL NO. 4 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-12)
7.
INSTALL NO. 3 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-13)
8.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
9.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
AV
AV–184
AUDIO / VISUAL – STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER
STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER
BODY ELECTRICAL
AUDIO
/ VISUAL
COMPONENTS
AV
AUDIO AMPLIFIER COVER
STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER ASSEMBLY
B139844E01
AUDIO / VISUAL – STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER
AV–185
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY RH (See page
SE-4)
3.
REMOVE AUDIO AMPLIFIER COVER
(a) Detach the 2 clips and amplifier cover.
4.
REMOVE STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER
ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the 3 bolts and stereo component amplifier.
I039615E01
E071459E01
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER
ASSEMBLY
(a) Connect the connector.
(b) Install the stereo component amplifier with the 3
bolts.
2.
INSTALL AUDIO AMPLIFIER COVER
(a) Attach the 2 clips to install the amplifier cover.
3.
INSTALL FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY RH (See page SE10)
4.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
E071459E01
I039615E01
AV
AV–186
AUDIO / VISUAL – STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER
5.
AV
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
AUDIO / VISUAL – FRONT NO. 1 SPEAKER
AV–187
FRONT NO. 1 SPEAKER
BODY ELECTRICAL
AUDIO
/ VISUAL
COMPONENTS
AV
FRONT NO. 1 SPEAKER ASSEMBLY
RIVET
Non-reusable part
B139841E01
AV–188
AUDIO / VISUAL – FRONT NO. 1 SPEAKER
REMOVAL
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH sides.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
AV
I036712E01
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR LOWER FRAME BRACKET
GARNISH LH (See page ED-11)
3.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR INSIDE HANDLE BEZEL LH
(See page ED-11)
4.
REMOVE DOOR PULL HANDLE (See page ED-11)
5.
REMOVE FRONT ARMREST BASE PANEL UPPER
LH (See page ED-11)
6.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR TRIM BOARD SUBASSEMBLY LH (See page ED-12)
7.
REMOVE FRONT NO. 1 SPEAKER ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Using a drill bit with a diameter of less than 4 mm
(0.16 in.), drill out the 3 rivet heads and remove the
speaker.
NOTICE:
• Do not drill the rivet at an angle as this will
cause damage to the drill and drill hole. Line
up the drill and rivet, and carefully drill out
the rivet head.
• Be careful. The cut rivet is very hot.
(c) Continue drilling and push out the remaining rivet
fragments.
(d) Using a vacuum cleaner, remove the rivet fragments
and shavings from the inside of the door.
AUDIO / VISUAL – FRONT NO. 1 SPEAKER
AV–189
INSTALLATION
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH and LH sides.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
(1)
(2)
(3)
INSTALL FRONT NO. 1 SPEAKER ASSEMBLY
(a) Using an air riveter or hand riveter, install the
speaker with 3 new rivets.
HINT:
Install the new strike rivets in the order shown in the
illustration.
I036713E03
NOTICE:
• Do not pry the rivet with the riveter, as this
will cause damage to the riveter and mandrel.
Riveter
AV
Mandrel
H002440E04
• Confirm that the rivets are seated properly
against the speaker. Do not tilt the riveter
when installing the rivet to the speaker. Do
not leave any space between the rivet head
and speaker.
Riveter
Riveter
H002441E03
• Do not leave any space between the speaker
and door. Firmly hold together the 2 items
while installing the rivet.
(b) Connect the connector.
Riveter
H002442E03
2.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR TRIM BOARD SUBASSEMBLY LH (See page ED-21)
3.
INSTALL FRONT ARMREST BASE PANEL UPPER LH
(See page ED-21)
4.
INSTALL DOOR PULL HANDLE (See page ED-22)
5.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR INSIDE HANDLE BEZEL LH
(See page ED-22)
6.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR LOWER FRAME BRACKET
GARNISH LH (See page ED-22)
7.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
AV–190
AUDIO / VISUAL – FRONT NO. 1 SPEAKER
8.
AV
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
AV–190
AUDIO / VISUAL – FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER
FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER
BODY ELECTRICAL
AUDIO
/ VISUAL
COMPONENTS
AV
FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER ASSEMBLY
B139838E01
AUDIO / VISUAL – FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER
AV–191
REMOVAL
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH and LH sides.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR LOWER FRAME BRACKET
GARNISH LH (See page ED-11)
3.
REMOVE FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER ASSEMBLY
(a) Detach the 3 claws and remove the speaker.
AV
I038877E02
AV–192
AUDIO / VISUAL – FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER
INSTALLATION
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH and LH sides.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
I038877E02
AV
1.
INSTALL FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER ASSEMBLY
(a) Attach the 3 claws to install the speaker.
2.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR LOWER FRAME BRACKET
GARNISH LH (See page ED-22)
3.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
4.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
AV–192
AUDIO / VISUAL – STEREO COMPONENT SPEAKER
STEREO COMPONENT SPEAKER
BODY ELECTRICAL
AUDIO
/ VISUAL
COMPONENTS
INSTRUMENT PANEL SPEAKER
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
AV
FRONT STEREO COMPONENT SPEAKER ASSEMBLY
B139842E01
AUDIO / VISUAL – STEREO COMPONENT SPEAKER
AV–193
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE FRONT STEREO COMPONENT SPEAKER
ASSEMBLY
(a) Detach the 4 claws and remove the instrument
panel speaker panel.
(b) Disconnect the connector.
I041455E02
(c) Remove the 2 screws and detach the clamp, and
then remove the speaker.
AV
I040164E02
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL FRONT STEREO COMPONENT SPEAKER
ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the speaker with the 2 screws and clamp.
(b) Connect the connector.
I040164E02
(c) Attach the 4 claws to install the speaker panel.
I041455E02
2.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
3.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
AV–194
AUDIO / VISUAL – REAR SPEAKER
REAR SPEAKER
BODY ELECTRICAL
AUDIO
/ VISUAL
COMPONENTS
AV
REAR SPEAKER ASSEMBLY
RIVET
Non-reusable part
B139839E01
AUDIO / VISUAL – REAR SPEAKER
AV–195
REMOVAL
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH sides.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
I036712E01
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE REAR DOOR INSIDE HANDLE BEZEL LH
(See page ED-28)
3.
REMOVE DOOR PULL HANDLE (See page ED-28)
4.
REMOVE REAR DOOR ARMREST BASE PANEL
UPPER LH (See page ED-28)
5.
REMOVE REAR DOOR TRIM BOARD SUBASSEMBLY LH (See page ED-28)
6.
REMOVE REAR SPEAKER ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Using a drill bit with a diameter of less than 4 mm
(0.16 in.), drill out the 3 rivet heads and remove the
speaker.
NOTICE:
• Do not drill the rivet at an angle as this will
cause damage to the drill and drill hole. Line
up the drill and rivet, and carefully drill out
the rivet head.
• Be careful as the cut rivet will be very hot.
(c) Continue drilling and push out the remaining rivet
fragments.
(d) Using a vacuum cleaner, remove the rivet fragments
and shavings from the inside of the door.
AV
AV–196
AUDIO / VISUAL – REAR SPEAKER
INSTALLATION
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH and LH sides.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
(1)
(2)
(3)
INSTALL REAR SPEAKER ASSEMBLY
(a) Using an air riveter or hand riveter, install the
speaker with 3 new rivets.
HINT:
Install the new strike rivets in the order shown in the
illustration.
I036713E03
NOTICE:
• Do not pry the rivet with the riveter, as this
will cause damage to the riveter and mandrel.
Riveter
AV
Mandrel
H002440E04
• Confirm that the rivets are seated properly
against the speaker. Do not tilt the riveter
when installing the rivet to the speaker. Do
not leave any space between the rivet head
and speaker.
Riveter
Riveter
H002441E03
• Do not leave any space between the speaker
and door. Firmly hold together the 2 items
while installing the rivet.
(b) Connect the connector.
Riveter
H002442E03
2.
INSTALL REAR DOOR TRIM BOARD SUBASSEMBLY LH (See page ED-37)
3.
INSTALL REAR DOOR ARMREST BASE PANEL
UPPER LH (See page ED-37)
4.
INSTALL DOOR PULL HANDLE (See page ED-37)
5.
INSTALL REAR DOOR INSIDE HANDLE BEZEL LH
(See page ED-37)
6.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
AUDIO / VISUAL – REAR SPEAKER
7.
AV–197
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
AV
AUDIO / VISUAL – REAR NO. 2 SPEAKER
AV–197
REAR NO. 2 SPEAKER
BODY ELECTRICAL
AUDIO
/ VISUAL
COMPONENTS
AV
REAR NO. 2 SPEAKER ASSEMBLY
B139840E03
AV–198
AUDIO / VISUAL – REAR NO. 2 SPEAKER
REMOVAL
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH sides.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
AV
I039619E02
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE REAR DOOR INSIDE HANDLE BEZEL LH
(See page ED-28)
3.
REMOVE DOOR PULL HANDLE (See page ED-28)
4.
REMOVE REAR DOOR ARMREST BASE PANEL
UPPER LH (See page ED-28)
5.
REMOVE REAR DOOR TRIM BOARD SUBASSEMBLY LH (See page ED-28)
6.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 SPEAKER ASSEMBLY
(a) Detach the 3 claws and remove the speaker.
AUDIO / VISUAL – REAR NO. 2 SPEAKER
AV–199
INSTALLATION
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH and LH sides.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
I039619E02
1.
INSTALL REAR NO. 2 SPEAKER ASSEMBLY
(a) Attach the 3 claws to install the speaker.
2.
INSTALL REAR DOOR TRIM BOARD SUBASSEMBLY LH (See page ED-37)
3.
INSTALL REAR DOOR ARMREST BASE PANEL
UPPER LH (See page ED-37)
4.
INSTALL DOOR PULL HANDLE (See page ED-37)
5.
INSTALL REAR DOOR INSIDE HANDLE BEZEL LH
(See page ED-37)
6.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
7.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
AV
AUDIO / VISUAL – RADIO ANTENNA CORD
AV–199
RADIO ANTENNA CORD
BODY ELECTRICAL
AUDIO
/ VISUAL
COMPONENTS
NO. 2 ANTENNA CORD SUB-ASSEMBLY
ANTENNA CORD SUB-ASSEMBLY
AV
B139848E02
AV–200
AUDIO / VISUAL – RADIO ANTENNA CORD
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE ROOF HEADLINING ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the roof headlining (see page IR-7).
3.
REMOVE ANTENNA CORD SUB-ASSEMBLY
AV
I038874E02
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the 10 clamps, ground bolt and antenna
cord.
4.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL SUB- ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the instrument panel (see page IP-5).
5.
REMOVE NO. 2 ANTENNA CORD SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Detach the 3 clamps and 2 claws, and then remove
the antenna cord.
AUDIO / VISUAL – RADIO ANTENNA CORD
AV–201
AV
I038961E02
AV–202
AUDIO / VISUAL – RADIO ANTENNA CORD
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL NO. 2 ANTENNA CORD SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Attach the 3 clamps and 2 claws to install the
antenna cord.
(b) Connect the connector.
AV
I038961E02
2.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the instrument panel (see page IP-11).
3.
INSTALL ANTENNA CORD SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Attach the 10 clamps. Install the antenna cord with
the bolt.
Torque: 7.0 N*m (71 kgf*cm, 62 in.*lbf)
AUDIO / VISUAL – RADIO ANTENNA CORD
AV–203
(b) Connect the connector.
AV
I038874E02
4.
INSTALL ROOF HEADLINING ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the roof headlining (see page IR-13).
5.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
6.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
AV–204
AUDIO / VISUAL – RADIO ANTENNA HOLDER
RADIO ANTENNA HOLDER
BODY ELECTRICAL
AUDIO
/ VISUAL
COMPONENTS
ANTENNA (CORD / POLE SEPARATE TYPE)
HOLDER ASSEMBLY
AV
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B139846E01
AUDIO / VISUAL – RADIO ANTENNA HOLDER
AV–205
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE ROOF HEADLINING ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the roof headlining (see page IR-7).
3.
REMOVE ANTENNA (CORD / POLE SEPARATE
TYPE) HOLDER ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the antenna nut.
(c) Remove the clamp and detach the 2 claws to
remove the antenna holder.
I038960E01
AV
I038872E02
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL ANTENNA (CORD / POLE SEPARATE
TYPE) HOLDER ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the antenna holder assembly on the roof and
align the antenna cord with the antenna nut cutout.
(b) Tighten the antenna holder assembly with the
antenna nut.
Torque: 5.0 N*m (51 kgf*cm, 44 in.*lbf)
(c) Attach the clamp.
(d) Connect the connector.
2.
INSTALL ROOF HEADLINING ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the roof headlining (see page IR-13).
3.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
I038873E01
AV–206
AUDIO / VISUAL – RADIO ANTENNA HOLDER
4.
AV
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
AUDIO / VISUAL – RADIO ANTENNA POLE
AV–207
RADIO ANTENNA POLE
BODY ELECTRICAL
AUDIO
/ VISUAL
COMPONENTS
ANTENNA POLE SUB-ASSEMBLY
AV
B139847E01
AV–208
AUDIO / VISUAL – RADIO ANTENNA POLE
REMOVAL
1.
I032662E01
AV
REMOVE ANTENNA POLE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the antenna pole by turning it
counterclockwise.
AUDIO / VISUAL – RADIO ANTENNA POLE
AV–209
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL ANTENNA POLE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the antenna pole by turning it clockwise.
AV
AUDIO / VISUAL – NETWORK GATEWAY ECU
AV–209
NETWORK GATEWAY ECU
BODY ELECTRICAL
AUDIO
/ VISUAL
COMPONENTS
AV
NETWORK GATEWAY ECU
B136397E01
AV–210
AUDIO / VISUAL – NETWORK GATEWAY ECU
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the instrument panel (see page IP-5).
3.
REMOVE NETWORK GATEWAY ECU
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the bolt and network gateway ECU.
I038881
INSTALLATION
AV
1.
INSTALL NETWORK GATEWAY ECU
(a) Install the network gateway ECU with the bolt.
(b) Connect the connector.
2.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the instrument panel (see page IP-11).
3.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
4.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
I038881
AUDIO / VISUAL – STEERING PAD SWITCH
AV–211
STEERING PAD SWITCH
PRECAUTION
1.
PRECAUTION FOR VEHICLE WITH SRS
(a) Some procedures in this section may affect the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS). Prior to
performing the procedures, read the SRS section's
"Precaution" ( see page RS-1).
AV
AV–212
AUDIO / VISUAL – STEERING PAD SWITCH
COMPONENTS
AV
STEERING PAD SWITCH RH
STEERING PAD SWITCH LH
B136395E01
AUDIO / VISUAL – STEERING PAD SWITCH
AV–213
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE NO. 2 STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER
3.
REMOVE NO. 3 STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER
4.
REMOVE STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY (See page RS268)
5.
REMOVE STEERING PAD SWITCH LH
(a) Detach the 2 claws and pull out the steering pad
switch.
(b) Disconnect the connector and remove the steering
pad switch.
AV
I038856E02
6.
REMOVE STEERING PAD SWITCH RH
(a) Detach the 2 claws and pull out the steering pad
switch.
(b) Disconnect the connector and remove the steering
pad switch.
I038855E02
INSTALLATION
1.
I038856E02
INSTALL STEERING PAD SWITCH LH
(a) Connect the connector.
(b) Attach the 2 claws to install the steering pad switch.
AV–214
AUDIO / VISUAL – STEERING PAD SWITCH
I038855E02
AV
2.
INSTALL STEERING PAD SWITCH RH
(a) Connect the connector.
(b) Attach the 2 claws to install the steering pad switch.
3.
INSTALL STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY (See page RS269)
4.
INSTALL NO. 2 STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER
5.
INSTALL NO. 3 STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER
6.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
7.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
8.
INSPECT STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY (See page RS269)
9.
CHECK SRS WARNING LIGHT (See page RS-269)
AUDIO / VISUAL – MICROPHONE AMPLIFIER
AV–215
MICROPHONE AMPLIFIER
BODY ELECTRICAL
AUDIO
/ VISUAL
COMPONENTS
MICROPHONE AMPLIFIER ASSEMBLY
AV
B139845E01
AV–216
AUDIO / VISUAL – MICROPHONE AMPLIFIER
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE MAP LIGHT ASSEMBLY (See page IR-12)
3.
REMOVE MICROPHONE AMPLIFIER ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 3 screws and print board.
I038938E01
(b) Detach the 4 claws and remove the amplifier cover.
(c) Disconnect the connector.
AV
I038939E02
(d) Remove the microphone amplifier.
I038940E01
AUDIO / VISUAL – MICROPHONE AMPLIFIER
AV–217
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL MICROPHONE AMPLIFIER ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the microphone amplifier.
(b) Connect the connector.
I038940E01
(c) Attach the 4 claws to install the amplifier cover.
AV
I038939E02
(d) Install the print board with the 3 screws.
I038938
2.
INSTALL MAP LIGHT ASSEMBLY (See page IR-15)
3.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
4.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
BC–1
ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED
BRAKE SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
1.
2.
TROUBLESHOOTING PRECAUTION
(a) When there is a malfunction with terminal contact
points or part installation problems, removal and
installation of the suspected problem parts may
return the system to the normal condition either
completely or temporarily.
(b) In order to determine the malfunctioning area, be
sure to check the conditions at the time the
malfunction occurred, such as DTC output and the
freeze frame data, and record it before
disconnecting each connector or removing and
installing parts.
(c) Since the system may be influenced by
malfunctions in systems other than the brake control
system, be sure to check for DTCs in other systems.
HANDLING PRECAUTION
(a) Do not remove or install the Enhanced VSC or
Electronically Controlled Brake (ECB) parts such as
the steering sensor, yaw rate sensor or brake pedal
stroke sensor except when required, as they need
to be adjusted correctly after removal or installation.
(b) Be sure to perform preparation before work and
confirmation after work is completed by following
the directions in the repair manual when working on
the Enhanced VSC or ECB system.
(c) Be sure to remove and install the ECU, actuator,
each sensor, etc. with the power switch OFF unless
otherwise specified in the inspection procedure.
(d) Be sure to remove the 2 main relays before removal
and installation, or replacement of the Enhanced
VSC or ECB parts.
(e) The removal or installation of the actuator, master
cylinder or stroke simulator as well as some other
procedures can cause the fluid level to drop below
the fluid reservoir port. If this happens when
performing such work, be sure to remove the 2
motor relays until the bleeding of the air in the
pipeline is completed.
HINT:
• When the pump motor is operated with the air in
the brake actuator hose, bleeding the air
becomes difficult due to air in the actuator.
• The skid control ECU may operate the stroke
simulator and drive the pump motor even when
the power switch is OFF.
BC
BC–2
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
3.
4.
BC
• The ECB system has its own auxiliary power
source. This system can be operated after
disconnecting the negative terminal from the
auxiliary battery (12 V) until the discharge is
completed.
• With the power switch OFF, the skid control ECU
can be operated for 2 minutes after the brake
operation is finished.
(f) Removal of the main relay and motor relay
(1) Wait for 2 minutes after turning the power switch
OFF, stopping the brake pedal operation and
closing the driver door before removing the 2
relays.
HINT:
The above situation occurs when the pump
motor operates to prepare for the next operation
just before brake control system turns off.
(g) When removing and installing the ECU, actuator
and each sensor, be sure to check that the normal
display is output in test mode inspection and in DTC
output inspection after installing all the parts.
DTC PRECAUTION
(a) Warnings for some DTCs cannot be cleared only by
repairing the malfunctioning parts. If the warning is
displayed after repair work, the DTC should be
cleared after turning the power switch OFF.
NOTICE:
If a DTC is cleared but the malfunction still
continues, the DTC is stored again.
FAIL-SAFE PRECAUTION
(a) When trouble occurs in the brake control systems,
the skid control ECU lights up the warning lights
(ECB, ABS, Enhanced VSC and BRAKE)
corresponding to the malfunctioning systems and
prohibits ABS, Enhanced VSC and brake assist
operation.
(b) The control of the ECB can be continued by only the
normal parts according to the malfunction.
HINT:
• If control of the ECB for any of the 4 wheels is
prohibited, that wheel loses brake booster
function or braking ability.
• If one of the 4 wheels loses brake booster
function, the feel when depressing brake pedal
changes as the stroke simulator (pedal reactive
force generating solenoid) operation is
prohibited.
• If control of the ECB for all wheels is prohibited,
the 2 front wheels lose brake booster function.
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
5.
6.
7.
DRUM TESTER PRECAUTION
(a) When using the drum tester, be sure to follow the
procedures below to prohibit the Enhanced VSC
operation.
NOTICE:
• Make sure that the Enhanced VSC warning
light is blinking (change to TEST MODE).
• Secure the vehicle with the lock chain for
safety.
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM PRECAUTION
(a) The CAN communication system is used for the
data communication between the skid control ECU,
the steering sensor, the yaw rate sensor
(deceleration sensor included) and other ECUs. If
there is trouble with the CAN communication line,
corresponding DTCs in the communication line are
output.
(b) If a CAN communication line DTC is output, repair
the malfunction in the communication line and
troubleshoot the Enhanced VSC system while data
communication is normal.
(c) Since the CAN communication line has its own
length and route, it cannot be repaired temporarily
with a bypass wire, etc.
NOTICES FOR INITIALIZATION
NOTICE:
When disconnecting the cable from the negative (-)
battery terminal, initialize the following system after
the cable is reconnected.
System Name
See Procedure
Power Window Control System
IN-32
8.
BC–3
NOTICES
(a) FOR HYBRID SYSTEM ACTIVATION
• When the warning light is illuminated or the
battery has been disconnected and reconnected,
pressing the power switch may not start the
system on the first try. If so, press the power
switch again.
• With the power switch's power mode changed to
ON (IG), disconnect the battery. If the key is not
in the key slot during reconnection, DTC B2799
may be output.
BC
BC–4
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
BRAKE STROKE SIMULATOR
CYLINDER SUB-ASSEMBLY
BRAKE ACTUATOR
ASSEMBLY
BRAKE FLUID RESERVOIR
REAR SPEED SENSOR
RH
BRAKE CONTROL POWER
SUPPLY
SPEED SENSOR
FRONT RH
SENSOR ROTOR
RH
REAR SPEED SENSOR
LH
BC
ENGINE ROOM RELAY BLOCK
- ABS NO. 1 RELAY
- ABS NO. 2 RELAY
- ABS MTR RELAY
- ABS MTR 2 RELAY
- ABS MAIN FUSE
- ABS MAIN2 FUSE
- ABS MAIN3 FUSE
- ABS 1 FUSE
- ABS 2 FUSE
FRONT SPEED
SENSOR LH
DOOR COURTESY
SWITCH FRONT LH
SENSOR ROTOR LH
DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
- ECU-IG FUSE
- GAUGE FUSE
C116292E01
BC–5
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
COMBINATION METER
- BRAKE CONTROL WARNING LIGHT
- BRAKE WARNING LIGHT
- VSC WARNING LIGHT
- SLIP INDICATOR LIGHT
GATEWAY ECU
HYBRID ECU
ECM
SKID CONTROL ECU
BRAKE PEDAL
STROKE SENSOR
STOP LIGHT SWITCH
DLC3
STEERING ANGLE
SENSOR
YAW RATE
(DECELERATION) SENSOR
SKID CONTROL BUZZER
BC
C116293E01
BC–6
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
Auxiliary Battery
Door Courtesy
Switch Front LH
Brake Control
Power Supply
ABS MTR 2
Relay
ABS MTR Relay
ABS NO. 1 Relay ABS NO. 2 Relay
Pump Motor
Accumulator Pressure
Sensor
Stop Light Switch
Master Cylinder
Pressure Sensor
Each Speed Sensor
Skid Control ECU
Wheel Cylinder
Pressure Sensor
BC
Brake Pedal Stroke
Sensor
Each Solenoid Valve
Parking Brake Switch
Liner Solenoid Valve
Brake Actuator
C126234E01
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
BC–7
EPS ECU
Master Cylinder
Yaw Rate
(Deceleration) Sensor
Stroke Simulator
Stroke Simulator Cut
Valve
Steering Angle Sensor
Hybrid ECU
Skid Control ECU
Gateway ECU
Brake Fluid Reservoir
Brake Fluid Level
Warning Switch
Brake Warning Light (Red)
Brake Control Warning Light
(Yellow)
ABS Warning Light
Skid Control Buzzer
SLIP Indicator Light
VSC Warning Light
Speedometer
: CAN Communication System
Combination Meter
: BEAN Signal
C126235E01
BC
BC–8
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
Brake Fluid Level
Warning Switch
Brake Fluid Reservoir
Master Cylinder
Brake Pedal
Stroke Sensor
Stroke Simulator
Brake Pedal
Stroke Simulator
Cut Valve (SCSS)
Brake Actuator
Accumulator
Master Cylinder
Pressure Sensor 2
(PMC2)
Relief
Valve
Master Cylinder
Pressure Sensor 1
(PMC1)
Pump Motor
SMC1
SMC2 : Changeover
SCSS Solenoid
Valve
Accumulator
Pressure Sensor
(PACC)
SMC2
SMC1
BC
C126236E01
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
1
2
3
BC–9
4
SLAFL
SLARR
SLARL
SLAFR
SLAFR
SLARR
SLAFL
SLARL : Linear
SLRFR Solenoid
SLRRR Valve
SLRFL
SLRRL
SLRRR
SLRFL
SLRFR
SLRRL
Wheel Cylinder
Pressure Sensor
(PFL)
Wheel
Cylinder
Pressure
Sensor
(PRR)
Wheel
Cylinder
Pressure
Sensor
(PFR)
Wheel
Cylinder
Pressure
Sensor
(PRL)
BC
Front Wheel
Cylinder LH
Rear Wheel
Cylinder RH
Front Wheel
Cylinder RH
Rear Wheel
Cylinder LH
C107651E02
Sender
Receiver
Signal
Line
Skid Control ECU
Gateway ECU
Warning signal
CAN communication
Skid Control ECU
Hybrid Control ECU
Vehicle wheel lock signal
CAN communication
Skid Control ECU
Hybrid Control ECU
Vehicle wheel speed sensor
signal
CAN communication
BC–10
BC
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
Sender
Receiver
Signal
Line
Skid Control ECU
Hybrid Control ECU
Enhanced VSC, torque control
signal
CAN communication
Skid Control ECU
Hybrid Control ECU
ABS operation signal
CAN communication
Skid Control ECU
Hybrid Control ECU
Cruise control cancel demand
signal
CAN communication
Skid Control ECU
Hybrid Control ECU
Communication error signal (from
HV to ECB)
CAN communication
Skid Control ECU
Hybrid Control ECU
Demand drive torque signal
CAN communication
Skid Control ECU
Hybrid Control ECU
Brake torque signal
CAN communication
Skid Control ECU
Hybrid Control ECU
Regeneration performing demand
signal
CAN communication
Skid Control ECU
Hybrid Control ECU
STP SW signal
CAN communication
Skid Control ECU
Hybrid Control ECU
STP SW open signal
CAN communication
Skid Control ECU
Hybrid Control ECU
Parking brake signal
CAN communication
Skid Control ECU
Yaw Rate (Deceleration) Sensor
Yaw rate (deceleration) signal
CAN communication
Skid Control ECU
EPS ECU
Steering signal
CAN communication
Hybrid Control ECU
Skid Control ECU
Regeneration prohibit signal
CAN communication
Hybrid Control ECU
Skid Control ECU
Regeneration deterioration notice
signal
CAN communication
Hybrid Control ECU
Skid Control ECU
Regeneration error signal
CAN communication
Hybrid Control ECU
Skid Control ECU
Performing torque recognition
signal
CAN communication
Hybrid Control ECU
Skid Control ECU
Performing torque recognition
signal
CAN communication
Hybrid Control ECU
Skid Control ECU
Destination signal
CAN communication
Hybrid Control ECU
Skid Control ECU
Throttle opening angle signal
CAN communication
Hybrid Control ECU
Skid Control ECU
Accelerator information signal
(Idle SW)
CAN communication
Hybrid Control ECU
Skid Control ECU
Communication error signal (from
ECB to HV)
CAN communication
Hybrid Control ECU
Skid Control ECU
Wheel lock braking start signal
CAN communication
Hybrid Control ECU
Skid Control ECU
Shift information signal
CAN communication
Hybrid Control ECU
Skid Control ECU
Ready condition signal
CAN communication
Hybrid Control ECU
Skid Control ECU
Braking torque demand signal
CAN communication
Hybrid Control ECU
Skid Control ECU
SLIP indicator ON demand signal
CAN communication
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
BC–11
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
COMPONENTS AND FUNCTION
Components
Functions
Skid control ECU*
Calculates brake control in accordance with sensor / ECU signals or
communication with hybrid ECU
Brake control power supply assembly*
Charges capacitor inside unit and supplies power source to system by
discharging when voltage of vehicle's power source drops
Speed sensor
Detects speed of each wheel and inputs data into skid control ECU
Pedal stroke sensor*
Detects brake pedal stroke and inputs data into skid control ECU
Yaw rate / deceleration sensor*
Detects forward / rearward and lateral acceleration, and then inputs
data into skid control ECU
Steering angle sensor
Detects steering wheel angle and steering wheel direction, and then
inputs data into skid control ECU
Accumulator
Accumulates fluid pressure generated by pump
Accumulator pressure sensor (PACC)
Detects accumulator pressure and inputs data into skid control ECU
Master cylinder
Generates pressure according to pedal effort
Brake fluid reservoir
Stores master cylinder system / power supply system brake fluid
Brake fluid level warning switch built into reservoir detects decrease of
brake fluid
Stroke simulator
Generates smooth pedal stroke in accordance with pedal effort during
system control
Stroke simulator cut valve (SCSS)
Changes intake / cutoff of brake fluid from master cylinder to stroke
simulator
Sends oil pressure generated in master cylinder to stroke simulator
during system control
Cuts brake fluid flow from master cylinder to stroke simulator when
system is not controlling
Master cylinder pressure sensor 1 (PMC)
Master cylinder pressure sensor 2 (PMC2)
Detects fluid pressure inside master cylinder and inputs data into skid
control ECU
Relief valve
Releases brake fluid into reservoir and prevents excessively high
power supply system pressure when pump operates continuously due
to malfunctions in parts such as accumulator oil pressure sensor
Wheel cylinder pressure sensor
Detects pressure in each wheel cylinder and inputs data into skid
control ECU
ABS NO. 1 relay
ABS NO. 2 relay
Supplies power to each solenoid according to skid control ECU
signals
Supplies power to skid control ECU
Supplies electricity and maintains operating condition for brake
system when power switch is OFF
ABS MTR relay
ABS MTR 2 relay
Supplies power to each motor according to skid control ECU signals
Drives relay 1 under normal condition and drives relay 2 under ABS
operation
Substitutes relay operation when one relay malfunctions
Changeover solenoid valve (SMC1, SMC2)
Changeover solenoid valve switches brake hydraulic pressure
passage depending on whether system is in operation or not
operation
Linear solenoid valve (SLA##, SLR##)
Controls wheel cylinder hydraulic pressure according to regenerative
braking force in order to generate braking force required by driver
under normal brake operation
Controls hydraulic pressure of each wheel cylinder under ABS, VSC
brake operation
SLA## adjusts pressure increase level
SLR## adjusts pressure decrease level
Stop light switch
Illuminates brake light when brake pedal is depressed (sends brake
ON signal to skid control ECU)
BRAKE warning light (Red)
Informs driver that there is trouble with ECB (normal brake) by turning
on
Informs driver when parking brake is applied and brake fluid level
drops by turning on
BC
BC–12
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
Components
Functions
BRAKE warning light ((Yellow) Brake Control warning light)
Informs driver when there is trouble with ECB or problem with brake
system that has no influence on driving, by turning on
ABS warning light
Informs driver that there is trouble with ABS by illuminating light
VSC warning light
Informs driver that there is trouble with Enhanced VSC by illuminating
light
SLIP indicator
Informs driver that Enhanced VSC and ABS are operating by blinking
light
Skid control buzzer
Informs driver when there is trouble with hydraulic pressure source or
power source by continuous buzzer sound
Informs that Enhanced VSC is operating by intermittent buzzer sound
HINT:
*: The "initialization of linear solenoid valve and
calibration" must be performed when the skid control
ECU, actuator, stroke sensor, yaw rate (deceleration)
sensor, brake control power supply assembly, and
steering sensor are replaced (see page BC-19). It is
necessary to perform zero point calibration of the yaw
rate (deceleration) sensor (see page BC-21).
BC
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
2.
BC–13
OPERATION DESCRIPTION
(a) ECB (Electronically Controlled Brake):
The skid control ECU receives signals from the
pedal stroke sensor, master cylinder sensor and
wheel cylinder pressure sensor. Based on these
signals, the skid control ECU calculates necessary
braking force for each wheel. The necessary
hydraulic pressure braking force signal is sent to the
hybrid control ECU via CAN communication. The
skid control ECU receives a braking force
(regenerative braking force) signal from the hybrid
control motor via CAN communication. The ECU
calculates the necessary hydraulic pressure braking
force based on the necessary braking force and
regenerative braking force.
Necessary hydraulic pressure is supplied to each
wheel by adjusting the brake accumulator (hydraulic
pressure source) pressure with each solenoid valve.
If there is a problem with the braking function, the
normally operating parts will maintain brake control
as a fail-safe.
Brake Actuator
Master Cylinder
Pressure Sensor
Brake Pedal Stroke
Sensor
Skid Control
ECU
Wheel Cylinder
Pressure Sensor
Each Solenoid
Each Wheel
Cylinder
BC
: CAN Communication System
Hybrid Control ECU
C126237E01
BC–14
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
(b) ABS with EBD and Enhanced VSC:
The skid control ECU receives a vehicle speed
signal from each speed sensor and detects wheel's
slip condition and then sends a control signal to the
solenoid.
The solenoid valve controls each wheel cylinder's
hydraulic pressure and optimizes hydraulic pressure
allocation to each wheel cylinder.
Brake Actuator
Each Speed Sensor
Skid Control
ECU
Solenoid Valve
Each Wheel
Cylinder
C126238E01
(c) BA (Brake Assist):
The skid control ECU receives the brake pedal
stroke sensor signal and hydraulic pressure signal
from the master cylinder pressure sensor and
determines whether brake assist operation is
necessary or not. If it is determined that brake assist
operation is necessary, the ECU changes target
hydraulic pressure applied to each wheel.
BC
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
BC–15
Brake Actuator
Brake Pedal
Stroke Sensor
Skid Control
ECU
Each Solenoid
Each Wheel
Cylinder
Master Cylinder
C126239E02
BC
BC–16
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
• Use these procedures to troubleshoot the electronically
controlled brake system.
• *: Use the intelligent tester.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS
NEXT
3
CHECK DTC AND FREEZE FRAME DATA*
NEXT
4
CLEAR DTC AND FREEZE FRAME DATA*
NEXT
5
PROBLEM SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION
Result
Result
Proceed to
Symptom does not occur
A
Symptom occur
B
B
GO TO STEP 7
A
BC
6
SYMPTOM SIMULATION
NEXT
7
CHECK FOR DTC*
Result
Result
Proceed to
There is no output
A
There is output
B
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
B
BC–17
GO TO STEP 9
A
8
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NEXT
CHECK FOR FLUID LEAKAGE AND GO TO STEP 11
9
SYMPTOM SIMULATION
NEXT
10
DTC CHART
NEXT
11
CIRCUIT INSPECTION*
NEXT
12
IDENTIFICATION OF PROBLEM
NEXT
13
REPAIR OR REPLACE
NEXT
14
NEXT
END
CONFIRMATION TEST*
BC
BC–18
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT
PROBLEMS
1.
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
HINT:
A momentary interruption (open circuit) in the connectors
and / or wire harness between the sensors and ECUs
can be detected in the ECU data monitor function of the
intelligent tester.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF and connect the
intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the DLC3.
Intelligent Tester
DLC3
CAN VIM
B126098E01
Harness Signal
OK
Momentary
interruption
1 sec. 1 sec. 1 sec.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (READY). Follow the onscreen directions on the intelligent tester (with CAN
VIM) to display the DATA LIST and select areas
where momentary interruption should be monitored.
HINT:
A momentary interruption (open circuit) cannot be
detected for 3 seconds after the power switch is
turned ON (READY) (initial check).
Intelligent Tester Display
OPEN
NORMAL
C106657E09
BC
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
SPD SEN FR
FR speed sensor open detection /
OPEN or NORMAL
NORMAL: Normal condition
-
SPD SEN FL
FL speed sensor open detection /
OPEN or NORMAL
NORMAL: Normal condition
-
SPD SEN RR
RR speed sensor open detection
/ OPEN or NORMAL
NORMAL: Normal condition
-
SPD SEN RL
RL speed sensor open detection /
OPEN or NORMAL
NORMAL: Normal condition
-
YAWRATE SEN
Yaw rate sensor open detection
NORMAL: Normal condition
-
DECELE SEN
G sensor open detection
NORMAL: Normal condition
-
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
STEERING SEN
Steering sensor open detection
NORMAL: Normal condition
-
M/C SEN 1
Master cylinder pressure sensor
1 open detection
NORMAL: Normal condition
-
M/C SEN 2
Master cylinder pressure sensor
1 open detection
NORMAL: Normal condition
-
STROKE SEN 1
Pedal stroke 1 open
NORMAL: Normal condition
-
FR W/C SEN
FR wheel cylinder open
NORMAL: Normal condition
-
FL W/C SEN
FL wheel cylinder open
NORMAL: Normal condition
-
RR W/C SEN
RR wheel cylinder open
NORMAL: Normal condition
-
RL W/C SEN
RL wheel cylinder open
NORMAL: Normal condition
-
HV COM
HV communication open
detection
NORMAL: Normal condition
-
ACC SEN
Accumulator pressure sensor
open detection
NORMAL: Normal condition
-
BC–19
HINT:
• If the status remains on, check the continuity
between the ECU and the sensors, or between
ECUs.
• The OPEN display on the intelligent tester
remains on for 1 second after the harness signal
changes from momentary interruption (open
circuit) to normal condition.
(c) While observing the screen, gently jiggle the
connector or wire harness between the ECU and
sensors, or between ECUs.
Result:
Display does not change.
HINT:
The connector and / or wire harness will have
momentary interruptions (open circuit) if the chart
fluctuates. Repair or replace connector and / or wire
harness as one of them is faulty.
F047126E05
BC
BC–20
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
INITIALIZATION
1.
BC
INITIALIZATION OF LINEAR SOLENOID VALVE AND
CALIBRATION
HINT:
• Perform "initialization of linear solenoid valve and
calibration" when the skid control ECU, brake actuator
or brake pedal stroke sensor is replaced.
• First perform the pedal stroke sensor zero point
calibration and then "initialization of linear solenoid
valve and calibration" when the brake stroke sensor is
removed / installed or the brake pedal height is
adjusted (see page BR-22).
• First bleed air and then perform initialization of linear
solenoid valve and calibration when the brake
actuator is replaced.
• "Initialization of linear solenoid valve and calibration"
cannot be performed again once it is stored unless
the data is cleared or damaged. Perform "initialization
of linear solenoid valve and calibration" after the
stored value is initialized, except when replacing the
skid control ECU.
• DTC C1259/59 is stored and ECB control is partly
prohibited when the power switch is turned ON
(READY) while the service plug grip of the HV battery
is removed, preventing "initialization of linear solenoid
valve and calibration" from being normally performed.
In this case, connect the service plug grip with the
power switch OFF and turn the power switch ON
(READY) again to cancel the warning (ECB control
prohibition).
• If there is a problem with auxiliary battery (12 V)
voltage, "initialization of linear solenoid valve and
calibration" cannot be completed normally. Make sure
to check battery voltage before performing
"initialization of linear solenoid valve and calibration".
• If the actuator's temperature is high, "initialization of
linear solenoid valve and calibration" may not be
completed normally. In that case, wait until the
temperature decreases and then perform
"initialization of linear solenoid valve and calibration".
• Do not depress the brake pedal during the
"initialization of linear solenoid valve and calibration"
procedure.
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
Intelligent Tester
DLC3
CAN VIM
B126098E01
0.25 sec.
0.25 sec.
ON
OFF
C108848E12
BC–21
(a) Clear stored value of "initialization of linear solenoid
valve and calibration".
(1) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to
the DLC3 with the power switch OFF.
(2) Turn the power switch ON (READY) with the
brake pedal released.
(3) Check that the P position switch indicator (P) is
on.
(4) Turn the intelligent tester ON and clear the
stored value of "initialization of linear solenoid
valve and calibration" following the screen.
(b) Perform "initialization of linear solenoid valve and
calibration".
(1) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with
the power switch OFF.
(2) Turn the power switch ON (READY) with the
brake pedal released.
(3) Check that the main switch (parking switch)
indicator (P) is on.
(4) Turn the power switch ON (READY) with the
brake pedal depressed to display the READY
indicator on the meter.
(5) Select the SIGNAL CHECK following the
intelligent tester screen.
(6) Leave the vehicle stationary without depressing
the brake pedal for 1 to 2 minutes. Check that
the interval between blinks of the Brake Control
warning light (BRAKE warning (Yellow))
changes from 1 second to 0.25 seconds.
NOTICE:
• Leave the meter's "READY" indicator on
during the "initialization of linear solenoid
valve and calibration". Do not drive the
vehicle or depress the brake pedal.
• A DTC that indicates trouble with
"initialization of linear solenoid valve and
calibration" is stored if entering the TEST
MODE with the shift lever in any position
other than P.
HINT:
• The time needed to complete "initialization of
linear solenoid valve and calibration" varies
depending on battery voltage.
• The Brake Control warning light (BRAKE
warning (Yellow)) blinks at 1 second intervals
during the "initialization of linear solenoid
valve and calibration" and changes to the
TEST MODE display when it is completed.
• The Brake Control warning light (BRAKE
warning (Yellow)) blinks at 0.25 second
intervals if the TEST MODE is normal.
BC
BC–22
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
2.
BC
(7) Check that DTC C1346/66 that indicates trouble
with stroke sensor zero point learning is not
output when the Brake Control warning light
changes to the TEST MODE display upon
"initialization of linear solenoid valve and
calibration" completion.
(8) Enter the NORMAL MODE from the SIGNAL
CHECK following the intelligent tester screen.
YAW RATE SENSOR / DECELERATION SENSOR
INITIALIZATION
HINT:
The zero point data of the yaw rate/deceleration sensor
stored in the skid control ECU must be cleared when the
yaw rate/deceleration sensor is replaced (see page BC21).
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
BC–23
CALIBRATION
1.
Replacing Parts
DESCRIPTION
(a) Zero point calibration is not performed until the data
is cleared when the zero point is once stored. Zero
point calibration should be performed after the zero
point is cleared if the yaw rate (deceleration) sensor
is replaced.
(b) Steering sensor zero point calibration is
automatically performed with the vehicle driving
straight.
(c) Follow the chart to perform calibration.
Necessary Operation
Skid Control ECU
Yaw rate (deceleration) sensor zero point calibration.
Yaw Rate (Deceleration) Sensor
1. Clearing zero point calibration data.
2. Yaw rate sensor and deceleration sensor zero point calibration.
2.
Intelligent Tester
3.
DLC3
CAN VIM
B126098E01
CLEAR ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a) Clearing the DTCs.
(1) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to
the DLC3.
(2) Turn the power switch ON (READY).
(3) Operate the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to
erase the codes.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester Operator's Manual
for further details.
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION OF YAW
RATE SENSOR AND DECELERATION SENSOR
NOTICE:
• While obtaining the zero point, do not vibrate the
vehicle by tilting, moving or shaking it and keep it
in a stationary condition. Do not start the engine.
• Be sure to do this on a level surface (with an
inclination less than 1 degree).
(a) Check that the steering wheel is in the centered
position and move the shift lever to the P position.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (READY).
(d) Operate the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to test
mode.
(e) Obtain the zero point of the yaw rate sensor and
deceleration sensor.
(1) Keep the vehicle in the stationary condition on a
level surface for 2 seconds or more.
(2) Check that the VSC warning light blinks.
HINT:
• If the VSC warning light does not blink,
perform the zero point calibration again.
• The zero point calibration is performed only
once after the system enters the test mode.
• Calibration cannot be performed again until
the stored data is cleared once.
(f) Turn the power switch OFF.
BC
BC–24
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
ABS Warning Light
BRAKE Warning
Light
USA
USA
CANADA
CANADA
TEST MODE PROCEDURE
1.
(Red)
VSC Warning Light
SLIP Indicator Light
Brake Control Warning Light
(Yellow)
CHECK WARNING LIGHT AND INDICATOR LIGHT
(a) Release the parking brake pedal.
NOTICE:
When releasing the parking brake, move the P
position switch into the P position to hold the
vehicle for safety.
HINT:
When the parking brake is applied or the level of the
brake fluid is low, the BRAKE warning light comes
on.
(b) When the power switch is ON (READY), check that
the ABS warning light, VSC warning light, BRAKE
warning light, Brake Control warning light and SLIP
indicator light come on for approximately 3 seconds.
HINT:
• If the indicator check result is not normal,
proceed to troubleshooting for the ABS warning
light circuit, VSC warning light circuit, BRAKE
warning light circuit, Brake Control warning light
circuit or SLIP indicator light circuit.
• If the indicator remains on, proceed to
troubleshooting for the light circuit below.
Trouble Area
See procedure
ABS warning light circuit
BC-170
VSC warning light circuit
BC-171
BRAKE warning light circuit
BC-176
Brake Control warning light circuit
BC-182
SLIP indicator light circuit
BC-187
C126240E01
2.
BC
CHECK SENSOR SIGNAL BY TEST MODE
HINT:
• Set the vehicle in the TEST MODE and perform the
following procedures to check operation of the
deceleration sensor, master cylinder pressure sensor,
speed sensor and yaw rate sensor.
• Check results are indicated by DTCs output only in
the TEST MODE.
• Perform the following procedures (step 1 to step 5) as
a set.
• When entering the test mode, the skid control ECU
records all the test mode codes and clears the codes
judged to be normal.
• During test mode, Enhanced VSC does not operate
regardless of whether or not the sensor check result
is normal or if there is a malfunction.
• When the mode returns to the normal mode, all the
test mode codes are cleared.
• The ABS warning light and VSC warning light comes
on if the sensor has a malfunction.
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
BC–25
(a) Step 1: Procedures for test mode
(1) Turn the power switch OFF.
(2) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to
the DLC3.
(3) Check that the steering wheel is in the centered
position and move the shift lever to the P
position.
(4) Turn the power switch ON (READY).
Intelligent Tester
DLC3
CAN VIM
B126098E01
(5) Select the SIGNAL CHECK following the
intelligent tester screen.
(6) Check that the ABS warning light and VSC
warning light indicates TEST MODE.
HINT:
If the ABS warning light and VSC warning light
do not blink, inspect the ABS warning light circuit
and VSC warning light circuit.
Test Mode
0.13 sec.
0.13 sec.
ON
OFF
C108848E16
Trouble Area
See Procedure
ABS warning light circuit
BC-170
VSC warning light circuit
BC-175
(7) Start the engine.
(b) Step 2: Check deceleration sensor
(1) Check that the ABS warning light is blinking in
TEST MODE.
(2) Keep the vehicle in the stationary condition on a
level surface for 1 second or more.
HINT:
The blinking pattern of the ABS warning light
and VSC warning light do not change. When the
sensor is normal and in the test mode, if the
above conditions are met, the check is
completed.
Start Position
Within +-5 deg.
End Position
F002135E14
(c) Step 3: Check yaw rate sensor
(1) Shift the shift lever to the D range and drive the
vehicle at the vehicle speed of approx. 5 km/h (3
mph), turn the steering wheel either to left or
right 90° or more, and drive in a half-circle
pattern.
NOTICE:
• The vehicle direction at the end should be
180 +-5 °or less.
• While turning do not move the shift lever
to the P position. Do not turn the power
switch OFF.
HINT:
• The turning direction is not important.
BC
BC–26
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
• Turning should be completed within 2.0
seconds. However, it is possible to change
the vehicle speed, stop or more backward.
(2) Stop the vehicle and move the shift lever to the P
position, check that the skid control buzzer
sounds for 3 seconds.
HINT:
• If the skid control buzzer sounds, the sensor
check is completed normally.
• If the skid control buzzer does not sound,
check the skid control buzzer circuit (see
page BC-191), then perform the sensor check
again.
• If the skid control buzzer still will not sound,
there is a malfunction in the Enhanced VSC
sensor, so check the DTC.
• Drive the vehicle in a half-circle pattern. At
the end of the turn, the direction of the vehicle
should be within 180 +-5° of its start position.
• Do not spin the wheels.
Test Mode
0.13 sec.
0.13 sec.
ON
OFF
C108848E16
BC
(d) Step 4: Check master cylinder pressure sensor
(1) Check that the ABS warning light is blinking in
TEST MODE.
(2) Leave the vehicle in a stationary condition and
the brake pedal in a free condition for 1 second
or more, and quickly depress the brake pedal
with a force of 98 N (10 kgf, 22 lbf) or more for 1
second or more.
(3) While the vehicle is stopped, release the brake
pedal.
(4) While the vehicle is stopped, quickly depress the
brake pedal once or more and check the ABS
warning light is lit for 3 seconds.
HINT:
• While the ABS warning light is lit, maintain the
condition a brake pedal load of approximately
98 N or more is applied.
• During the test mode, the ABS warning light
comes on for 3 seconds every time the above
pedal operation.
• If the master cylinder pressure sensor check
is not completed, randomly depressing the
brake pedal will cause the negative pressure
to decrease further and the sensor check will
be difficult to be completed.
• If the negative pressure is insufficient, the
master cylinder pressure sensor check may
not be completed. In this case, turn the
engine idle to make the negative pressure
sufficient.
• Strongly depress the brake pedal when the
negative pressure is insufficient. The brake
warning light may come on with the fail-safe
function.
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
(e) Step 5: Check speed sensor
(1) Check the ABS warning light is blinking of TEST
MODE.
(2) Start the sensor signal check.
(3) Drive the vehicle straight forward. Drive the
vehicle at a speed of 45 to 80 km/h (28 to 50
mph) or higher for several seconds and check
that the ABS warning light goes off.
Test Mode
0.13 sec.
BC–27
0.13 sec.
ON
OFF
C108848E16
Vehicle Speed
Test
Check
0 to 45 km/h
(0 to 28 mph)
Low speed test
Response of sensors
45 to 80 km/h
(28 to 50 mph)
Middle speed test
Deviations of sensor
signal
(f)
NOTICE:
• Before the speed sensor check, the yaw
rate sensor, deceleration sensor and
master cylinder pressure sensor checks
should be completed.
• Before the speed sensor check, the yaw
rate sensor, deceleration sensor and
master cylinder pressure sensor checks
should be completed.
• After the warning light goes off, driving at
50 mph (80 km/h) or more will cause the
test mode codes to be recorded again,
before the speed reaches at 50 mph (80
km/h), decelerate and stop the vehicle.
• If the sensor check is not completed, the
ABS warning light blinks even while
driving and the ABS does not operate.
HINT:
If the speed sensor check is completed, the ABS
warning light does not come on while driving and
blinks at test mode when the vehicle stops.
Step 6: Check end of sensor
(1) If the sensor check is completed, the ABS
warning light blinks (test mode) when the vehicle
stops and the warning light is off when the
vehicle is driving.
NOTICE:
• When the yaw rate sensor, deceleration
sensor, speed sensor and master cylinder
pressure sensor checks are completed,
the sensor check is completed.
• If the sensor check is not completed, the
ABS warning light blinks even while the
vehicle is driving and the ABS does not
operate.
• If a DTC is detected during the test mode,
the ABS warning light and VSC warning
light comes on.
BC
BC–28
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
Test Mode
0.13 sec.
0.13 sec.
ON
OFF
C108848E16
(g) Step 7: Read test mode
(1) Using intelligent tester (with CAN VIM), check
the DTCs in the test mode (refer to step 8).
NOTICE:
• If only the DTCs are displayed, repair the
malfunctioning area and clear the DTC.
Check if the ABS warning light and VSC
warning light are normal.
• If only the test mode codes are displayed,
perform the test mode again.
• If DTCs or test mode codes are displayed,
repair the malfunction area, clear the
DTCs and perform the test mode
inspection.
HINT:
• The test mode codes and DTCs are
displayed.
• If the ABS is normal, the ABS warning light
comes on for 0.25 seconds and goes off for
0.25 seconds repeatedly.
(h) Step 8: DTC of test mode
DTC of ABS sensor check function
BC
Code No.
Diagnosis
Trouble Area
C1271/71
Low output voltage of right front speed sensor
•
•
•
Right front speed sensor
Sensor installation
Sensor rotor
C1272/72
Low output voltage of left front speed sensor
•
•
•
Left front speed sensor
Sensor installation
Sensor rotor
C1273/73
Low output voltage of right rear speed sensor
•
•
•
Right rear speed sensor
Sensor installation
Sensor rotor
C1274/74
Low output voltage of left rear speed sensor
•
•
•
Left rear speed sensor
Sensor installation
Sensor rotor
C1275/75
Abnormal change in output voltage of right
front speed sensor
Right front sensor rotor
C1276/76
Abnormal change in output voltage of left front
speed sensor
Left front speed sensor rotor
C1277/77
Abnormal change in output voltage of right
rear speed sensor
Right rear sensor rotor
C1278/78
Abnormal change in output voltage of left rear
speed sensor
Left rear speed sensor rotor
C1279/79
Deceleration sensor is faulty
•
•
C1281/81
Master cylinder pressure sensor output signal
is faulty
Master cylinder pressure sensor
C0371/71
Signal malfunction
Yaw rate sensor (Deceleration sensor)
Yaw rate (Deceleration) sensor
Sensor installation
HINT:
The code in this table are output only in test mode.
BC–29
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
Use the table below to help determine the cause of the
problem symptom. The potential causes of the symptoms are
listed in order of probability in the "Suspected area" column of
the table. Check each symptom by checking the suspected
areas in the order they are listed. Replace parts as
necessary.
Electronically controlled brake system
Symptom
ABS does not operate, BA does not operate, EBD
does not operate
ABS does not operate efficiently, BA does not operate
efficiently, EBD does not operate efficiently
ABS warning light abnormal (Remains on)
ABS warning light abnormal (Does not come on)
DTC of ABS check cannot be done
Sensor signal check cannot be done
Suspected area
See page
1. Check the DTC again and make sure that the normal code
is output.
BC-38
2. IG power source circuit and ground circuit
BC-84
3. Front speed sensor circuit
BC-54
4. Rear speed sensor circuit
BC-61
5. Check the brake actuator with an intelligent tester (with CAN
VIM). (Check brake actuator operation using the ACTIVE
TEST (Check brake actuator operation using the ACTIVE
TEST function.) If abnormal, check the hydraulic circuit for
leakage.
BC-205
6. If the symptoms still occur even after the above suspected
areas are inspected and proved to be normal, replace the skid
control ECU.
-
1. Check the DTC again and make sure that the normal code
is output.
BC-38
2. Front speed sensor circuit
BC-54
3. Rear speed sensor circuit
BC-61
4. Stop light switch circuit
BC-104
5. Check the brake actuator with an intelligent tester. If
abnormal, check the hydraulic circuit for leakage.
BC-205
6. If the symptoms still occur even after the above suspected
areas are inspected and proved to be normal, replace the skid
control ECU.
-
1. ABS warning light circuit
BC-166
2. Skid control ECU
-
1. ABS warning light circuit
BC-170
2. Skid control ECU
-
1. Check the DTC again and make sure that the normal code
is output.
BC-38
2. TC and CG terminal circuit
BC-194
3. If the symptoms still occur even after the above suspected
areas are inspected and proved to be normal, replace the skid
control ECU.
-
1. TS and CG terminal circuit
BC-198
2. Skid control ECU
-
BC
BC–30
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
Symptom
VSC does not operate
SLIP indicator light abnormal
DTC of VSC check cannot be done
VSC warning light abnormal (Remains on)
VSC warning light abnormal (Does not come on)
Brake Control warning light abnormal (Remains on)
Brake Control warning light abnormal (Does not come
on)
BC
Suspected area
See page
1. Check the DTC again and make sure that the normal code
is output.
BC-38
2. IG power source circuit and ground circuit
BC-84
3. Check the hydraulic circuit for leakage.
-
4. Front speed sensor circuit
BC-54
5. Rear speed sensor circuit
BC-61
6. Yaw rate / Deceleration sensor circuit
BC-70
7. Steering sensor circuit
BC-75
8. If the symptoms still occur even after the above suspected
areas are inspected and proved to be normal, replace the skid
control ECU.
-
1. SLIP indicator light circuit
BC-187
2. Skid control ECU
-
1. Check the DTC again and make sure that the normal code
is output.
BC-38
2. TC terminal circuit
BC-194
3. If the symptoms still occur even after the above suspected
areas are inspected and proved to be normal, replace the skid
control ECU.
-
1. Check the DTC again and make sure that the normal code
is output.
BC-38
2. VSC warning circuit
BC-171
3. If the symptoms still occur even after the above suspected
areas are inspected and proved to be normal, replace the skid
control ECU.
-
1. Check the DTC again and make sure that the normal code
is output.
BC-38
2. VSC warning circuit
BC-175
3. If the symptoms still occur even after the above suspected
areas are inspected and proved to be normal, replace the skid
control ECU.
-
1. Check the DTC again and make sure that the normal code
is output.
BC-38
2. Brake Control warning circuit
BC-182
3. If the symptoms still occur even after the above suspected
areas are inspected and proved to be normal, replace the skid
control ECU.
-
1. Check the DTC again and make sure that the normal code
is output.
BC-38
2. Brake Control warning circuit
BC-186
3. If the symptoms still occur even after the above suspected
areas are inspected and proved to be normal, replace the skid
control ECU.
-
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
BC–31
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
2.
S7
CHECK BATTERY VOLTAGE
(a) Measure the battery voltage.
Standard voltage:
10 to 14 V
CHECK SKID CONTROL ECU
(a) Measure the voltage and resistance between each
terminal or between each terminal and the body
ground.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3, and check the communication condition with
the skid control ECU.
(c) Using an oscilloscope, check that the pulse
generates between each terminal or between each
terminal and the body ground.
NOTICE:
• Each inspection should be performed from
the back of the connector with the connector
connected to the skid control ECU.
• The voltage between the terminals of the
brake actuator assembly may become 0 V
due to the fail-safe function when the ECB
warning light comes on (malfunctioning).
S9
S8
S10
C126241E02
HINT:
Inspect the ECU from the wire harness side while
the connector is connected.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
R1+ (S7-2) - GND (S7-1)
P-W
Main relay power 1
Push power switch ON
(READY)
9.1 to 13.6 V
BS1 (S7-3) - GND (S7-1)
B-W
Battery source 1
Push power switch ON
(READY)
Approx. 1.5 sec. after
pushing power switch ON
(READY)
8.8 to 14 V
BC
BC–32
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
SMC1 (S7-4) - GND (S71)
Y-W
Master cut solenoid 1
output
Push power switch ON
(READY)
Brake pedal depressed
approx. 1.5 sec. after
pushing power switch ON
(READY)
Below 1.5 V
+BCTY (S7-5) - GND (S71)
V-W
Courtesy power input
Driver door open → close
Approx. 5 sec. 8 to 16 V
→ Below 1 V
SLAFR- (S7-6) - GND (S7- W - W
1)
FR solenoid (-) output
Push power switch ON
(READY)
Approx. 1.5 sec. after
pushing power switch ON
(READY)
Below 1.5 V
SLAFR+ (S7-7) - GND
(S7-1)
R-W
FR solenoid (+) output
Push power switch ON
(READY)
Brake pedal depressed
approx. 1.5 sec. after
pushing power switch ON
(READY)
Pulse generation
(see waveform 1)
E (S7-8) - GND (S7-1)
L-W
Pressure sensor ground
Push power switch OFF
Below 1 Ω
VCM1 (S7-9) - GND (S71)
P-W
Pressure sensor power
Push power switch ON
(READY)
4.75 to 5.25 V
MR1+ (S7-11) - GND (S71)
GR - W
Motor relay power 1
Push power switch ON
(READY)
Approx. 1.5 sec. after
pushing power switch ON
(READY)
8.8 to 14 V
SR1 (S7-12) - GND (S7-1)
L-W
Main relay output 1
Push power switch ON
(READY)
Approx. 1.5 sec. or more
after pushing power switch
ON (READY)
Below 1 V
SCSS (S7-13) - GND (S71)
BR - W
Stroke simulator cut
solenoid output
Push power switch ON
(READY)
Brake pedal depressed
Below 1.5 V
SLARL+ (S7-15) - GND
(S7-1)
L-W
RL solenoid (+) output
Push power switch ON
(READY)
Brake pedal depressed
approx. 1.5 sec. after
pushing power switch ON
(READY)
Pulse generation
(see waveform 1)
SLRRL+ (S7-16) - GND
(S7-1)
W-W
RL solenoid (+) output
Push power switch ON
(READY)
Brake pedal depressed
approx. 1.5 sec. after
pushing power switch ON
(READY)
Pulse generation
(see waveform 1)
SLRFR+ (S7-17) - GND
(S7-1)
Y-W
FR solenoid (+) output
Push power switch ON
(READY)
After approx. 1.5 sec.,
brake pedal depressed →
released
Pulse generation
(see waveform 2)
PRL (S7-18) - GND (S7-1)
G-W
RL pressure sensor input
Push power switch ON
(READY)
Brake pedal released
0.3 to 0.8 V
SG1 (S7-20) - GND (S7-1)
BR - W
Pressure sensor shield
ground 1
Push power switch OFF
Below 1 Ω
PACC (S7-21) - GND (S71)
W-W
Accumulator pressure
sensor input
Push power switch ON
(READY)
After pump motor
operates and stops by
pedal operation
3.3 to 4.7 V
FR- (S7-22) - GND (S7-1)
L-W
FR sensor (-) input
Push power switch OFF
Below 1 Ω
BC
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
BC–33
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
PFR (S7-23) - GND (S7-1)
Y-W
FR pressure sensor input
Push power switch ON
(READY)
Brake pedal released
0.3 to 0.8 V
MR1 (S7-25) - GND (S7-1)
L-W
Motor relay output 1
Push power switch ON
(READY)
Pump motor is operating
Below 1.5 V
SLRRL- (S7-26) - GND
(S7-1)
P-W
RL solenoid (-) output
Push power switch ON
(READY)
Approx. 1.5 sec. after
pushing power switch ON
(READY)
Below 1.5 V
SLARL- (S7-27) - GND
(S7-1)
LG - W
RL solenoid (-) output
Push power switch ON
(READY)
Approx. 1.5 sec. after
pushing power switch ON
(READY)
Below 1.5 V
MTT (S7-29) - GND (S7-1)
R-W
Motor test input
Push power switch ON
(READY)
Pump motor is operating
3.5 V or higher
PMC1 (S7-30) - GND (S71)
R-W
Master pressure sensor
input 1
Push power switch ON
(READY)
Brake pedal released
0.3 to 0.8 V
PCK1 (S7-31) - GND (S71)
B-W
Pressure sensor check
output 1
Push power switch ON
(READY)
Approx. 1.5 sec. after
pushing power switch ON
(READY)
4.75 to 5.25 V
FR+ (S7-32) - GND (S7-1)
P-W
FR sensor (+) input
Vehicle speed input
Pulse generation
(see waveform 3)
SLRFR- (S7-34) - GND
(S7-1)
B-W
FR solenoid (-) output
Push power switch ON
(READY)
Approx. 1.5 sec. after
pushing power switch ON
(READY)
Below 1.5 V
+BI1 (S8-3) - GND (S8-1,
2)
B-W
Main relay power input 1
Push power switch OFF
10 to 14 V
+BO1 (S8-5) - GND (S8-1,
2)
Y-W
Main relay power output 1
Push power switch ON
(IG)
8.8 to 14 V
IG1 (S8-7) - GND (S8-1,
2)
B-W
IG1 power
Push power switch ON
(IG)
10 to 14 V
RSS (S8-10) - GND (S8-1,
2)
BR - W
Speed sensor shield
ground
Push power switch OFF
Below 1 Ω
BZ (S8-12) - GND (S8-1,
2)
BR - W
Warning buzzer output
Push power switch ON
(READY)
Buzzer is operating
Below 1 V
STP (S8-14) - GND (S8-1,
2)
R-W
Stop light switch signal
input
Push power switch ON
(READY)
Brake pedal depressed →
released
8 to 14 V → Below 1 V
CAN-L (S8-18) - GND (S81, 2)
W-W
CAN communication
(Send and receive-)
Check DTC using
intelligent tester
CAN communication's
DTC is not output
CAN-H (S8-19) - GND
(S8-1, 2)
B-W
CAN communication
(Send and receive+)
Check DTC using
intelligent tester
CAN communication's
DTC is not output
FAIL (S8-20) - GND (S8-1,
2)
P-W
Capacitor communication
(Receive)
Push power switch ON
(READY)
Approx. 1.5 sec. after
pushing power switch ON
(READY)
Pulse generation
(See waveform 5)
SP1 (S8-22) - GND (S8-1,
2)
V-W
Speed meter output
Vehicle speed input
Pulse generation
(See waveform 4)
BC
BC–34
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
RL- (S8-27) - GND (S8-1,
2)
B-W
RL sensor (-) input
Push power switch OFF
Below 1 Ω
D/G (S8-28) - GND (S8-1,
2)
W-W
Diagnosis output
Push power switch ON
(READY)
9.1 to 13.6 V
ENA (S8-30) - GND (S8-1,
2)
B-W
Capacitor communication
(Send)
Push power switch ON
(READY)
Approx. 1.5 sec. after
pushing power switch ON
(READY)
Pulse generation
(See waveform 6)
TS (S8-32) - GND (S8-1,
2)
L-W
Sensor diagnosis check
input
Push power switch ON
(READY)
Below 1.5 V → 9.1 to 13.6
V
VBZ (S8-33) - GND (S8-1,
2)
B-W
Warning buzzer power
Push power switch ON
(READY)
9.1 to 13.6 V
RL+ (S8-35) - GND (S8-1,
2)
W-W
RL sensor (+) input
Vehicle speed input
Pulse generation
(See waveform 3)
+BO2 (S9-4) - GND (S9-1,
2)
W - W-B
Main relay power output 2
Push power switch ON
(READY)
8.8 to 14 V
+BI2 (S9-5) - GND (S9-1,
2)
R - W-B
Main relay power input 2
Push power switch OFF
10 to 14 V
VCSK (S9-6) - GND (S9-1,
2)
B - W-B
Stroke sensor power
Push power switch ON
(READY)
3.75 to 4.95 V
SSK (S9-7) - GND (S9-1,
2)
Shielded - W-B
Stroke sensor shield
ground
Push power switch OFF
Below 1 Ω
SKG (S9-8) - GND (S9-1,
2)
W - W-B
Stroke sensor ground
Push power switch OFF
Below 1 Ω
PKB (S9-14) - GND (S9-1,
2)
R - W-B
Parking brake signal input
Parking brake applied →
released
Below 1.5 V → 9.1 to 13.6
V
SKS1 (S9-21) - GND (S91, 2)
R - W-B
Stroke sensor signal input 1
Push power switch ON
(READY)
Brake pedal released
0.46 to 1.35 V
SKS2 (S9-22) - GND (S91, 2)
G - W-B
Stroke sensor signal input 2
Push power switch ON
(READY) Brake pedal
released
2.56 to 4.35 V
RR- (S9-23) - GND (S9-1,
2)
B - W-B
RR sensor (-) input
Push power switch OFF
Below 1 Ω
RR+ (S9-31) - GND (S9-1,
2)
W - W-B
RR sensor (+) input
Vehicle speed input
Pulse generation
(See waveform 3)
SLAFL+ (S10-1) - GND
(S10-4)
P - W-B
FL solenoid (+) output
Push power switch ON
(READY)
Brake pedal depressed
approx. 1.5 sec. after
pushing power switch ON
(READY)
Pulse generation
(See waveform 1)
SLAFL- (S10-2) - GND
(S10-4)
O - W-B
FL solenoid (-) output
Push power switch ON
(READY)
Approx. 1.5 sec. after
pushing power switch ON
(READY)
Below 1.5 V
SMC2 (S10-3) - GND
(S10-4)
LG - W-B
Master cut solenoid 2
output
Push power switch ON
(READY)
Brake pedal depressed
approx. 1.5 sec. after
pushing power switch ON
(READY)
Below 1.5 V
IG2 (S10-5) - GND (S104)
O - W-B
IG2 power
Push power switch ON
(READY)
10 to 14 V
LBL (S10-6) - GND (S104)
P - W-B
Brake fluid level switch
input
Reservoir level switch
OFF → ON
4 to 4.65 V→ Below 1.5 V
BC
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
BC–35
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
BS2 (S10-7) - GND (S104)
P - W-B
Battery source 2
Push power switch ON
(READY)
Approx. 1.5 sec. after
pushing power switch ON
(READY)
8.8 to 14 V
SLRFL+ (S10-8) - GND
(S10-4)
Y - W-B
FL solenoid (+) output
Push power switch ON
(READY)
After approx. 1.5 sec.,
brake pedal depressed →
released
Pulse generation
(See waveform 2)
SLARR- (S10-9) - GND
(S10-4)
P - W-B
RR solenoid (- ) output
Push power switch ON
(READY)
Approx. 1.5 sec. after
pushing power switch ON
(READY)
Below 1.5 V
SG2 (S10-12) - GND
(S10-4)
Shielded - W-B
Pressure sensor shield
ground 2
Push power switch OFF
Below 1 Ω
FSS (S10-13) - GND
(S10-4)
BR - W-B
Speed sensor shield
ground
Push power switch OFF
Below 1 Ω
VCM2 (S10-14) - GND
(S10-4)
B - W-B
Pressure sensor power 2
Push power switch ON
(READY)
4.75 to 5.25 V
SR2 (S10-15) - GND
(S10-4)
V - W-B
Main relay output 2
Push power switch ON
(READY)
Approx. 1.5 sec. after
pushing power switch ON
(READY)
Below 1 V
R2+ (S10-17) - GND (S104)
Y - W-B
Main relay power 2
Push power switch ON
(READY)
9.1 to 13.6 V
SLRRR- (S10-18) - GND
(S10-4)
BR - W-B
RR solenoid (-) output
Push power switch ON
(READY)
Approx. 1.5 sec. after
pushing power switch ON
(READY)
Below 1.5 V
SLARR+ (S10-19) - GND
(S10-4)
V - W-B
RR solenoid (+) output
Push power switch ON
(READY)
Brake pedal depressed
approx. 1.5 sec. after
pushing power switch ON
(READY)
Pulse generation
(See waveform 1)
SLRRR+ (S10-20) - GND
(S10-4)
R - W-B
RR solenoid (+) output
Push power switch ON
(READY)
Brake pedal depressed
approx. 1.5 sec. after
pushing power switch ON
(READY)
Pulse generation
(See waveform 1)
PCK2 (S10-21) - GND
(S10-4)
L - W-B
Pressure sensor check
output 2
Push power switch ON
(READY)
4.75 to 5.25 V
FL- (S10-22 ) - GND (S104)
G - W-B
FL sensor (-) input
Push power switch OFF
Below 1 Ω
PFL (S10-23) - GND (S104)
R - W-B
FL pressure sensor input
Push power switch ON
(READY)
Brake pedal released
0.3 to 0.8 V
MR2+ (S10-25) - GND
(S10-4)
R - W-B
Motor relay power 2
Push power switch ON
(READY)
Approx. 1.5 sec. after
pushing power switch ON
(READY)
8.8 to Below 14 V
SLRFL- (S10-26) - GND
(S10-4)
L - W-B
FL solenoid (-) output
Push power switch ON
(READY)
Approx. 1.5 sec. after
pushing power switch ON
(READY)
Below 1.5 V
BC
BC–36
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
PMC2 (S10-27) - GND
(S10-4)
W - W-B
Master pressure sensor
input 2
Push power switch ON
(READY)
Brake pedal released
0.3 to 0.8 V
FL+ (S10-28) - GND (S104)
R - W-B
FL sensor (+) input
Vehicle speed input
Pulse generation
(See waveform 3)
E2 (S10-29) - GND (S104)
G - W-B
Pressure sensor ground 2
Push power switch OFF
Below 1 Ω
MR2 (S10-30) - GND
(S10-4)
G - W-B
Motor relay output 2
Push power switch ON
(READY)
Pump motor is operating
Below 1.5 V
PRR (S10-31) - GND
(S10-4)
Y - W-B
RR pressure sensor input
Push power switch ON
(READY)
Brake pedal released
0.3 to 0.8 V
(d) Using an oscilloscope, check the waveform 1.
Waveform 1 (Reference)
Waveform 1
GND
Item
Content
Symbols (Terminal No.)
SLAFR+ (S7-7) - GND (S7-1)
SLARL+ (S7-15) - GND (S7-1)
SLRRL+ (S7-16) - GND (S7-1)
SLAFL+ (S10-2) - GND (S10-4)
SLARR+ (S10-19) - GND (S10-4)
SLRRR+ (S10-20) - GND (S10-4)
Tool Setting
5 V/DIV., 200 msec./DIV.
Condition
Brake pedal depressed
NOTICE:
Normal waveform is output only when BS 1 and
2 voltages are normal (10 to 14 V).
F047507E03
(e) Using an oscilloscope, check the waveform 2.
Waveform 2 (Reference)
Waveform 2
GND
BC
F047507E04
Item
Content
Symbols (Terminal No.)
SLRFR+ (S7-17) - GND (S7-1)
SLRFL+ (S10-8) - GND (S10-4)
Tool Setting
5 V/DIV., 200 msec./DIV.
Condition
Brake pedal depressed → released
NOTICE:
Normal waveform is output only when BS 1 and
2 voltages are normal (10 to 14 V).
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
(f)
Waveform 3
BC–37
Using an oscilloscope, check the waveform 3.
Waveform 3 (Reference)
Item
Content
Symbols (Terminal No.)
FR+ (S7-32) - GND (S7-1)
RL+ (S8-35) - GND (S8-1, 2)
RR+ (S9-31) - GND (S9-1, 2)
FL+ (S10-28) - GND (S10-4)
Tool Setting
1 V/DIV., 200 msec./DIV.
Condition
While driving at approximately 18 mph
(30 km/h)
GND
NOTICE:
As the vehicle speed (tire rotating speed)
becomes faster, the cycle becomes shorter and
the output voltage becomes larger.
F047509E03
(g) Using an oscilloscope, check the waveform 4.
Waveform 4 (Reference)
Waveform 4
Item
Content
Symbols (Terminal No.)
SP1 (S8-22) - GND (S8-1, 2)
Tool Setting
5 V/DIV., 50 msec./DIV.
Condition
While driving at approximately 12 mph
(20 km/h)
NOTICE:
As the vehicle speed (tire rotating speed)
becomes faster, the cycle becomes shorter.
GND
F047510E03
(h) Using an oscilloscope, check the waveform 5.
Waveform 5 (Reference)
Waveform 5
GND
F047511E03
Item
Content
Symbols (Terminal No.)
FAIL (S8-20) - GND (S8-1, 2)
Tool Setting
5 V/DIV., 200 msec./DIV.
Condition
Power switch ON (READY)
BC
BC–38
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
(i)
Waveform 6
Using an oscilloscope, check the waveform 6.
Waveform 6 (Reference)
Item
Content
Symbols (Terminal No.)
ENA (S8-30) - GND (S8-1, 2)
Tool Setting
5 V/DIV., 100 msec./DIV.
Condition
Power switch ON (READY)
GND
F047511E05
ABS Warning Light
BRAKE Warning
Light
USA
USA
CANADA
CANADA
(Red)
VSC Warning Light
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
1.
DIAGNOSIS FUNCTION
On the combination meter, the BRAKE warning light
(Red), BRAKE warning light ((Yellow) Brake Control
warning light), ABS warning light or VSC warning light
come on to inform the driver if trouble occurs in the skid
control ECU input signal or actuator system. If there is
trouble in the oil pressure source (pump motor,
accumulator) or the vehicle power supply is insufficient,
the skid control buzzer sounds to warn the driver.
SLIP Indicator Light
Brake Control Warning Light
(Yellow)
BC
C126240E01
Item
Condition
ABS Warning Light
Comes on when a failure in ABS, EBD or Enhanced VSC occurs
VSC Warning Light
Comes on when a failure in Enhanced VSC occurs
SLIP Indicator Light
Comes on while operating ABS or Enhanced VSC
BRAKE Warning Light
((Yellow) Brake Control Warning Light)
Comes on when a minor failure that does not affect normal driving
occurs in the brake control system
BRAKE Warning Light
(Red)
Comes on when a failure in the brake control system
Comes on when the parking brake is applied or the brake fluid level is
low.
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
2.
3.
BC–39
DIAGNOSIS DISPLAY FUNCTION
DTCs detected by the ECU can be read by connecting
the intelligent tester and performing the read command.
The DTC has a detailed code that can be checked on the
freeze frame data screen.
BRAKE SYSTEM DISPLAY INITIAL CHECK
Turn the power switch ON (READY) and check that the
ABS warning light, VSC warning light, Brake Control
warning light, BRAKE warning light and SLIP indicator
light come on, and then go off after approximately 3
seconds.
If any of the lights do not come on, check the bulb and
the multiplex communication diagnosis.
DTC CHECK / CLEAR
Intelligent Tester
1.
CHECK DTC (When Using Intelligent Tester)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (READY).
(c) Read the DTCs following the prompts on the tester
screen.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual for
further details.
2.
CHECK DTC (When not Using Intelligent Tester)
(a) Using SST, connect terminals TC and CG of the
DLC3.
SST 09843-18040
(b) Turn the power switch ON (READY).
DLC3
CAN VIM
B126098E01
CG
TC
H100769E17
BC
BC–40
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
(c) Read the DTC from the Brake Control warning light,
ABS warning light and VSC warning light on the
combination meter.
Brake Control Warning Light
(Yellow)
ABS Warning Light
Light
Read DTC
Brake Control warning light
DTC of ECB system
ABS warning light
DTC of ABS system
VSC warning light
DTC of Enhanced VSC system
HINT:
• If no code appears, inspect the diagnostic circuit
or ABS warning light circuit.
USA
CANADA
VSC Warning Light
Trouble Area
See procedure
TC and CG terminal circuit
BC-194
Brake Control warning light circuit
BC-182
ABS warning light circuit
BC-166
VSC warning light circuit
BC-171
C126242E01
• As an example, the illustration below shows the
blinking patterns of the normal system code and
trouble codes 11 and 21.
(d) Codes are explained in the Diagnostic Trouble Code
(see page BC-47).
(e) After completing the check, disconnect terminals TC
and CG of the DLC3, and turn off the display.
If 2 or more DTCs are detected at the same time,
the DTCs will be displayed in ascending order.
Normal System Code
0.25 sec.
2 sec.
0.25 sec.
ON
OFF
DTCs 11 and 21
0.5 sec.
1.5 sec.
4 sec.
0.5 sec.
2.5 sec.
ON
OFF
BC
DTC 11
DTC 21
C108860E01
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
Intelligent Tester
BC–41
3.
CLEAR DTC (When Using Intelligent Tester)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (READY).
(c) Operate the intelligent (with CAN VIM) tester to
clear the codes.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual for
further details.
4.
CLEAR DTC (When not Using Intelligent Tester)
(a) Using SST, connect terminals TC and CG of the
DLC3.
SST 09843-18040
(b) Turn the power switch ON (READY).
DLC3
CAN VIM
B126098E01
CG
TC
H100769E17
BR03890E03
5.
(c) Clear the DTCs stored in the ECU by depressing
the brake pedal 8 times or more within 5 seconds.
(d) Check that the warning light indicates a normal
system code.
(e) Remove SST.
HINT:
Clearing the DTCs cannot be performed by
removing the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal or the ECU-IG fuse.
END OF CHECK/CLEAR
(a) Turn the power switch ON (READY).
(b) Check that the Brake Control warning light, ABS
warning light and VSC warning light go off within
approximately 3 seconds.
BC
BC–42
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
FREEZE FRAME DATA
1.
Intelligent Tester Display
BC
FREEZE FRAME DATA
HINT:
• Whenever a DTC is detected or the ABS operates,
the skid control ECU stores the current vehicle
(sensor) state as freeze frame data.
• The skid control ECU stores the number of times
(maximum: 31) the power switch has been turned
from OFF to the ON (IG or READY) position since the
last time ABS was activated. However, if the vehicle
was stopped or at low speed (4.3 mph (7 km/h) or
less), or if a DTC is detected, the skid control ECU will
not count the number since then.
• Freeze frame data at the time the ABS operates: The
skid control ECU stores and updates data whenever
the ABS system operates. When the ECU stores data
at the time a DTC is detected, the data stored when
the ABS operated is erased.
• Freeze frame data at the time a DTC is detected:
When the skid control ECU stores data at the time a
DTC is detected, no updates will be performed until
the data is cleared.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (READY).
(c) From the display on the tester, select the FREEZE
FRAME DATA.
Measurement Item
Reference Value
BUZZER
Buzzer
Buzzer ON: ON, OFF: OFF
RESERVOIR SW
Reservoir level warning switch
Reservoir level warning switch ON: ON, OFF:
OFF
PKB SW
Parking brake switch
Parking brake switch ON: ON, OFF: OFF
SHIFT POSITION
Shift position
Fail
P, N
R
D (M)
4
3
2
L
VSC/TRC OFF SW
VSC OFF switch
VSC OFF switch ON: ON, OFF: OFF
STOP LIGHT SW
Stop light switch
Stop light switch ON: ON, OFF: OFF
SYSTEM
SYSTEM
ABS
VSC (TRC)
BA
HAB
FAIL SAFE
PBA
PB
NO SYS
# IG ON
# IG ON
0 to 31
VEHICLE SPD
Vehicle speed
Speed indicated on speedometer
STEERING ANG
Steering sensor
Left turn: Increase
Right turn: Drop (Deceleration)
YAW RATE
Yaw rate sensor
-128 to 127
MAS CYL PRESS
Master cylinder pressure
0 to 5 V
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
Intelligent Tester Display
Measurement Item
Reference Value
PEDAL STROKE
Stroke sensor
0 to 5.1 V
THROTTLE
Throttle position sensor
Release accelerator pedal:
Approx. 0 deg.
Depress accelerator pedal:
Approx. 125 deg.
MAS PRESS GRADE
Master pressure sensor grade
30 to 225 Mpa/s
G (RIGHT & LEFT)
Right and left G
-1869 to 1869
G (BACK & FORTH)
Back and forth G
-1869 to 1869
SPD GRADE
Vehicle speed grade
-1869 to 1869
FR W/C SENS
FR wheel cylinder pressure sensor
0 to 5 V
FL W/C SENS
FL wheel cylinder pressure sensor
0 to 5 V
RR W/C SENS
RR wheel cylinder pressure sensor
0 to 5 V
RL W/C SENS
RL wheel cylinder pressure sensor
0 to 5 V
ACCUM PRESS
Accumulator pressure sensor
0 to 5 V
MAS CYL PRESS 2
Master cylinder pressure sensor 2
0 to 5 V
PEDAL STROKE 2
Stroke sensor 2
0 to 5 V
MTT
MTT
0 to 5 V
IG1 VOLTAGE
Voltage value of IG1
0 to 20 V
IG2 VOLTAGE
Voltage value of IG2
0 to 20 V
BS1
BS1
0 to 20 V
BS2
BS2
0 to 20 V
VM1
VM1
0 to 20 V
VM2
VM2
0 to 20 V
+B1
+B1
0 to 5 V
+B2
+B2
0 to 5 V
FR TARGET OIL
Target oil pressure (FR)
0 to 20 V
FL TARGET OIL
Target oil pressure (FL)
0 to 20 V
RR TARGET OIL
Target oil pressure (RR)
0 to 20 V
RL TARGET OIL
Target oil pressure (RL)
0 to 20 V
SLAFR CUR
Current of SLAFR solenoid
0 to 1.5 A
SLAFL CUR
Current of SLAFL solenoid
0 to 1.5 A
SLARR CUR
Current of SLARR solenoid
0 to 1.5 A
SLARL CUR
Current of SLARL solenoid
0 to 1.5 A
SLRFR CUR
Current of SLRFR solenoid
0 to 1.5 A
SLRFL CUR
Current of SLRFL solenoid
0 to 1.5 A
SLRRR CUR
Current of SLRRR solenoid
0 to 1.5 A
SLRRL CUR
Current of SLRRL solenoid
0 to 1.5 A
WHEEL SPD FR
Front right wheel speed
0 to 255 km/h
WHEEL SPD FL
Front left wheel speed
0 to 255 km/h
WHEEL SPD RR
Rear right wheel speed
0 to 255 km/h
WHEEL SPD RL
Rear left wheel speed
0 to 255 km/h
CAPA MODE
Capacitor mode
ON: ON, OFF: OFF
SCSS
SCSS
ON: ON, OFF: OFF
SMC2
SMC2
ON: ON, OFF: OFF
SMC1
SMC1
ON: ON, OFF: OFF
MOTOR RELAY 2
Motor relay 2
ON: ON, OFF: OFF
MOTOR RELAY 1
Motor relay 1
ON: ON, OFF: OFF
MAIN RELAY 2
Main relay 2 for ECB
ON: ON, OFF: OFF
MAIN RELAY 1
Main relay 1 for ECB
ON: ON, OFF: OFF
DETAILED CODE
Detailed code for freeze DTC
0 to 65535
BC–43
BC
BC–44
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
FAIL-SAFE CHART
Master Cylinder
Brake Control Power
Supply Assembly
Brake Actuator
Battery
Accumulator
Skid Control ECU
Each Solenoid Valve
Each Wheel Cylinder
: Hydraulic Pressure
C126243E01
1.
BC
Trouble Area
FAIL-SAFE FUNCTION
(a) If a malfunction occurs in the skid control ECU,
sensor signal, or actuator, the normally operating
parts will maintain brake control.
(b) If the brake control is stopped under such conditions
as when trouble occurs with a hydraulic pressure
source, the pressure generated in the master
cylinder by the driver is applied to the wheel cylinder
to ensure braking force.
(c) A power back-up unit is built in as an additional
power source to supply stable power to the system.
(d) If the regenerative brake alone does not operate
under such conditions as a communication error
with the HV ECU, control is switched so that all
braking force is generated with the hydraulic
pressure brake.
Generated Braking Force
Skid control ECU
Normally operating parts will control brake and generate braking force
Hydraulic pressure controlling parts
Normally operating parts will control brake and generate braking force
Hydraulic pressure source
Braking force generated by the driver
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
BC–45
DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST
1.
READ DATA LIST
HINT:
Using the intelligent tester's DATA LIST allows switch,
sensor, actuator and other item values to be read without
removing any parts. Reading the DATA LIST early in
troubleshooting in one way to save time.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Turn the intelligent tester on.
(d) Read the DATA LIST according to the display on the
tester.
Skid control ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
YAW RATE
Yaw rate sensor / Min.: -128 deg/
s, Max.: 128 deg/s
Min.: -128 deg/s
Max.: 128 deg/s
-
YAW ZERO VALUE
Memorized zero value / Min.: 128 deg/s, Max.: 128 deg/s
Min.: -128 deg/s
Max.: 128 deg/s
-
STEERING ANG
Steering sensor / Min.: -1152 deg,
Max.: 1150.875 deg
Left turn: Increase
Right turn: Decrease
-
1 SYS BRAKE
1 system brake / OPERATE or
BEFORE
OPERATE: During operation
-
REGEN CO OPRT
Regenerate co operation /
OPERATE or BEFORE
OPERATE: During operation
-
AIR BLD SUPPORT
Air bleed availability / SUPPORT
or NOT SUP
SUPPORT: During support
-
PKB SW
Parking brake switch / ON or OFF
ON: Parking brake applied
OFF: Parking brake released
-
STOP LIGHT SW
Stop light switch / ON or OFF
ON: Brake pedal depressed
OFF: Brake pedal released
-
TEST MODE
Test mode / NORMAL or TEST
NORMAL: Normal mode
TEST: During test mode
-
RESERVOIR SW
Reservoir level warning switch /
ON or OFF
ON: Reservoir level Normal
OFF: Reservoir level Low
-
WHEEL SPD FR
Wheel speed sensor (FR) reading
/ Min.: 0 km/h (0 mph), Max.: 326
km/h (202 mph)
Actual wheel speed
Similar speed as indicated on
speedometer
WHEEL SPD FL
Wheel speed sensor (FL) reading
/ Min.: 0 km/h (0 mph), Max.: 326
km/h (202 mph)
Actual wheel speed
Similar speed as indicated on
speedometer
WHEEL SPD RR
Wheel speed sensor (RR)
reading / Min.: 0 km/h (0 mph),
Max.: 326 km/h (202 mph)
Actual wheel speed
Similar speed as indicated on
speedometer
WHEEL SPD RL
Wheel speed sensor (RL) reading
/ Min.: 0 km/h (0 mph), Max.: 326
km/h (202 mph)
Actual wheel speed
Similar speed as indicated on
speedometer
VEHICLE SPD
Maximum wheel speed sensor
reading / Min.: 0 km/h (0 mph),
Max.: 326 km/h (202 mph)
Actual vehicle speed
Speed indicated on speedometer
IG VOLTAGE
ECU power supply voltage / TOO
HIGH, TOO LOW or NORMAL
TOO HIGH: 9.5 V or over
NORMAL: 9.5 V
TOO LOW: Below 9.5 V
-
DECELERAT SENS
Deceleration sensor 1 reading /
Min.: -1.869 G, Max.: 1.869 G
Approximately 0 +-0.13 G when
vehicle is still
Reading changes when vehicle is
bounced
DECELERAT SENS2
Deceleration sensor 2 reading /
Min.: -1.869 G, Max.: 1.869 G
Approximately 0 +-0.13 G when
vehicle is still
Reading changes when vehicle is
bounced
BC
BC–46
BC
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
MAS CYL PRS 1
Master cylinder pressure sensor
1 reading / Min.: 0 V, Max.: 5 V
When brake pedal is released:
0.3 to 0.9 V
Reading increases when brake
pedal is depressed
MAS CYL PRS 2
Master cylinder pressure sensor
2 reading / Min.: 0 V, Max.: 5 V
When brake pedal is released:
0.3 to 0.9 V
Reading increases when brake
pedal is depressed
SLAFR CUR
Current of SLAFR solenoid / Min.:
0 A, Max.: 3 A
When brake pedal is released: 0
A
-
SLAFL CUR
Current of SLAFL solenoid / Min.:
0 A, Max.: 3 A
When brake pedal is released: 0
A
-
SLARR CUR
Current of SLARR solenoid / Min.:
0 A, Max.: 3 A
When brake pedal is released: 0
A
-
SLARL CUR
Current of SLARL solenoid / Min.:
0 A, Max.: 3 A
When brake pedal is released: 0
A
-
SLRFR CUR
Current of SLRFR solenoid / Min.:
0 A, Max.: 3 A
When brake pedal is released: 0
A
-
SLRFL CUR
Current of SLRFL solenoid / min.:
0 A, max.: 3 A
When brake pedal is released: 0
A
-
SLRRR CUR
Current of SLRRR solenoid/ Min.:
0 A, Max.: 3 A
When brake pedal is released: 0
A
-
SLRRL CUR
Current of SLRRL solenoid / Min.:
0 A, Max.: 3 A
When brake pedal is released: 0
A
-
PEDAL STROKE
Stroke sensor / Min.: 0 V, Max.: 5
V
When brake pedal is released:
0.7 to 1.3 V
-
PEDAL STROKE 2
Stroke sensor 2 / Min.: 0 V, Max.:
5V
When brake pedal is released:
3.7 to 4.3 V
-
MC 2
MC2 / ON or OFF
ON: Operate
-
MC 1
MC1 / ON or OFF
ON: Operate
-
SSC
SSC / ON or OFF
ON: Operate
-
PATTERN
A pattern drive is under
enforcement / ON or OFF
ON: Operate
-
MAIN RELAY 2
Main relay 2 for ECB / ON or OFF
ON: Operate
-
MAIN RELAY 1
Main relay 1 for ECB / ON or OFF
ON: Operate
-
ACC PRESS SENS 1
Accumulator pressure sensor 1 /
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 5 V
Specified value: 3.2 to 4.0 V
-
FR PRESS SENS
Front right pressure sensor / Min.:
0 V, Max.: 5 V
When brake pedal is released:
0.3 to 0.9 V
-
FL PRESS SENS
Front left pressure sensor / Min. 0
V, Max.: 5 V
When brake pedal is released:
0.3 to 0.9 V
-
RR PRESS SENS
Rear right pressure sensor / Min.:
0 V, Max.: 5 V
When brake pedal is released:
0.3 to 0.9 V
-
RL PRESS SENS
Rear left pressure sensor / Min. 0
V, Max.: 5 V
When brake pedal is released:
0.3 to 0.9 V
-
MOTOR RELAY 2
Motor relay 2 / ON or OFF
ON: Motor relay ON
-
MOTOR RELAY 1
Motor relay 1 / ON or OFF
ON: Motor relay ON
-
VSC
Existence of VSC / WITH or
WITHOUT
WITH: WITH Enhanced VSC
System
-
2 FRAMES
There is two or more frame for
freeze frame data / YES or NO
YES: There are two or more
freeze frame data
-
REGEN TORQ FR
Regenerative request torque (FR)
/ Min.: 0 N*m, Max.: 4080 N*m
ECB is not operate: 0 N*m
-
REGEN TORQ FL
Regenerative request torque (FL)
/ Min.: 0 N*m, Max.: 4080 N*m
ECB is not operate: 0 N*m
-
REGEN TORQ RR
Regenerative request torque
(RR) / Min.: 0 N*m, Max.: 4080
N*m
-
-
REGEN TORQ RL
Regenerative request torque (RL)
/ Min.: 0 N*m, Max.: 4080 N*m
-
-
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
SPD SEN FR
FR speed sensor open detection /
OPN-DET or NORMAL
NORMAL: Normal condition
-
SPD SEN FL
FL speed sensor open detection /
OPN-DET or NORMAL
NORMAL: Normal condition
-
SPD SEN RR
RR speed sensor open detection
/ OPN-DET or NORMAL
NORMAL: Normal condition
-
SPD SEN RL
RL speed sensor open detection /
OPN-DET or NORMAL
NORMAL: Normal condition
-
YAW RATE SEN
Yaw rate sensor open detection /
OPN-DET or NORMAL
NORMAL: Normal condition
-
DECELE SEN
Deceleration sensor open
detection / OPN-DET or
NORMAL
NORMAL: Normal condition
-
STEERING SEN
Steering sensor open detection /
OPN-DET or NORMAL
NORMAL: Normal condition
-
M/C SEN 1
Master cylinder pressure sensor
1 open detection / OPN-DET or
NORMAL
NORMAL: Normal condition
-
M/C SEN 2
Master cylinder pressure sensor
2 open detection / OPN-DET or
NORMAL
NORMAL: Normal condition
-
STROKE SEN 1
Stroke sensor open detection /
OPN-DET or NORMAL
NORMAL: Normal condition
-
FR W/C SEN
FR wheel cylinder pressure
sensor open detection / OPNDET or NORMAL
NORMAL: Normal condition
-
FL W/C SEN
FL wheel cylinder pressure
sensor open detection / OPNDET or NORMAL
NORMAL: Normal condition
-
RR W/C SEN
RR wheel cylinder pressure
sensor open detection / OPNDET or NORMAL
NORMAL: Normal condition
-
RL W/C SEN
RL wheel cylinder pressure
sensor open detection / OPNDET or NORMAL
NORMAL: Normal condition
-
HV COM
HV communication open
detection / OPN-DET or
NORMAL
NORMAL: Normal condition
-
ACC SEN
Accumulator pressure sensor
open detection / ERROR or
NORMAL
ERROR: Momentary interruption
NORMAL: Normal condition
-
BUZZER
Buzzer / ON or OFF
ON: Buzzer ON
OFF: Buzzer OFF
-
RESERVOIR SW
Reservoir level warning switch /
ON or OFF
ON: Reservoir level normal
OFF: Reservoir level low
-
SHIFT POSITION
Shift position / FAIL / L / 2 / 3 / 4 /
D (M) / R / P.N
-
-
VSC/TRC OFF SW
TRAC control switch / ON or OFF
ON: TRAC control switch ON
-
STOP LIGHT SW
Stop light switch / ON or OFF
ON: Operate
-
SYSTEM
SYSTEM / ABS / VSC (TRAC) /
BA / HAB / FAIL SAFE / PB /
NOSYS
-
-
# IG ON
# IG ON / 0 to 31
0
-
STEERING ANG
Steering sensor / Min.: -1152 deg,
Max.: 1150.875 deg
Left turn: Increase
Right turn: Decrease
-
YAW RATE
Yaw rate sensor/ Min.: -128 deg/
s, Max.: 128 deg/s
Min.: -128 deg/s
Max.: 128 deg/s
-
BC–47
BC
BC–48
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
MAS CYL PRESS
Master cylinder pressure / Min.: 0
V, Max.: 5 V
When brake pedal is released:
0.3 to 0.9 V
Reading increases when brake
pedal is depressed
PEDAL STROKE
Stroke sensor / Min.: 0 V, Max.: 5
V
When brake pedal is released
(SKS1): 0.7 to 1.5 V
When brake pedal is released
(SKS2): 3.7 to 4.3 V
-
THROTTLE
Throttle position sensor / Min.: 0
deg, Max.: 125 deg
Release accelerator pedal:
Approx. 0 deg.
Depress accelerator pedal:
Approx. 90 deg.
-
MAS PRESS GRADE
Master pressure sensor grade /
Min.: -30Mpa/s, Max.: 225 Mpa/s
When brake pedal is released: 0
MPa
-
G (RIGHT & LEFT)
Right and left G / Min.: -1.869 G,
Max.: 1.869 G
Approximately 0 +-0.13 G when
vehicle is still
-
G (BACK & FORTH)
Back and forth G / Min.: -1.869 G,
Max.: 1.869 G
Approximately 0 +-0.13 G when
vehicle is still
-
SPD GRADE
Vehicle speed grade /Min.: -1.869
G, Max.: 1.869 G
Approximately 0 +-0.13 G when
vehicle is still
-
# CODES
Number of DTC recorded / Min.:
0, Max.: 255
Min.: 0, max.: 39
-
2.
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST
HINT:
Performing the intelligent tester's ACTIVE TEST allows
relay, VSV, actuator and other items to be operated
without removing any parts. Performing the ACTIVE
TEST early in troubleshooting is one way to save time.
The DATA LIST can be displayed during the ACTIVE
TEST.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (READY).
(c) Perform the ACTIVE TEST according to the display
on the tester.
Skid control ECU
BC
Item
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
ABS WARN LIGHT
Turns ABS warning light ON / OFF
Observe combination meter
VSC WARN LIGHT
Turns VSC warning light ON / OFF
Observe combination meter
SLIP INDI LIGHT
Turns SLIP indicator light ON / OFF
Observe combination meter
BRAKE WARN LIGHT
Turns BRAKE warning light ON / OFF
Observe combination meter
VSC/BR WARN BUZ
Turns VSC / BRAKE warning buzzer ON /
OFF
Buzzer can be heard
ECB INDI LIGHT
Turns Brake Control warning light ON / OFF
Observe combination meter
MAIN RELAY 1
Turns MAIN RELAY 1 ON / OFF
Operation of solenoid (clicking sound) can be
heard
MAIN RELAY 2
Turns MAIN RELAY 2 ON / OFF
Operation of solenoid (clicking sound) can be
heard
MC 1
Turns Master cut valve 1 activation ON / OFF
Operation of solenoid (clicking sound) can be
heard
MC 2
Turns Master cut valve 2 activation ON / OFF
Operation of solenoid (clicking sound) can be
heard
MOTOR RELAY 1
Turns MOTOR RELAY 1 ON / OFF
Operation of solenoid (clicking sound) can be
heard
MOTOR RELAY 2
Turns MOTOR RELAY 2 ON / OFF
Operation of solenoid (clicking sound) can be
heard
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
BC–49
Item
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
ECB INVALID
Turns ECB invalid ON / OFF
Operation of solenoid (clicking sound) can be
heard
ACC PATTERN
Actuator air bleeding pattern activation ON /
OFF
Operation of solenoid (clicking sound) can be
heard
SCC PATTERN
Stroke simulator cut valve pattern activation
ON / OFF
Operation of solenoid (clicking sound) can be
heard
POWER SUPPLY 1
Power supply air bleeding pattern activation 1
ON / OFF
Operation of solenoid (clicking sound) can be
heard
POWER SUPPLY 2
Power supply air bleeding pattern activation 2
ON / OFF
Operation of solenoid (clicking sound) can be
heard
RL AIR BLEEDING
RL wheel air bleeding pattern activation ON /
OFF
Operation of solenoid (clicking sound) can be
heard
RR AIR BLEEDING
RR wheel air bleeding pattern activation ON /
OFF
Operation of solenoid (clicking sound) can be
heard
ZERO DOWN
Accumulator zero down activation ON / OFF
Operation of solenoid (clicking sound) can be
heard
PUMP PATTERN
Pump check pattern activation ON / OFF
Operation of solenoid (clicking sound) can be
heard
DRAIN PATTERN
Drain system air bleeding pattern activation
ON / OFF
Operation of solenoid (clicking sound) can be
heard
BC
BC–50
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
HINT:
If a malfunction code is displayed during the DTC check,
check the circuit indicated by the DTC. For details of each
code, refer to the respective "DTC No." in the DTC chart.
DTC chart of ABS
Trouble Area
See page
C0200/31
DTC No.
Front Speed Sensor RH
Circuit
Detection Item
251
252
253
254
256
257
258
259
260
261
262
- Right front speed sensor
- Speed sensor circuit
- Sensor rotor
- Sensor installation
BC-54
C0205/32
Front Speed Sensor LH
Circuit
264
265
266
267
268
269
270
271
272
273
274
275
- Left front speed sensor
- Speed sensor circuit
- Sensor rotor
- Sensor installation
BC-54
C0210/33
Rear Speed Sensor RH
Circuit
277
278
279
280
281
282
283
284
285
286
287
288
- Right rear speed sensor
- Speed sensor circuit
- Sensor rotor
- Sensor installation
BC-61
C0215/34
Rear Speed Sensor LH
Circuit
290
291
292
293
294
295
296
297
298
299
300
301
- Left rear speed sensor
- Speed sensor circuit
- Sensor rotor
- Sensor installation
BC-61
C1235/35
Foreign Object is Attached
on Tip of Front Speed
Sensor RH
302
- Right front speed sensor
- Speed sensor circuit
- Sensor installation
BC-79
C1236/36
Foreign Object is Attached
on Tip of Front Speed
Sensor LH
303
- Left front speed sensor
- Speed sensor circuit
- Sensor installation
BC-79
C1238/38
Foreign Object is Attached
on Tip of Rear Speed
Sensor RH
304
- Right rear speed sensor
- Speed sensor circuit
- Sensor installation
BC-79
BC
INF Code
BC–51
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
DTC No.
Detection Item
C1239/39
Foreign Object is Attached
on Tip of Rear Speed
Sensor LH
305
INF Code
- Left rear speed sensor
- Speed sensor circuit
- Sensor installation
Trouble Area
See page
BC-79
C1243/43
Acceleration Sensor Stuck
Malfunction
317
- Yaw rate (deceleration)
sensor
- Skid control ECU
BC-70
C1244/44
Open or Short in
Acceleration Sensor
Circuit
314
- Yaw rate (deceleration)
sensor
- Yaw rate (deceleration)
sensor installation
- Zero point calibration not
done
- Skid control ECU
BC-70
C1245/45
Acceleration Sensor
Output Malfunction
313
- Yaw rate (deceleration)
sensor
- Zero point calibration not
done
- Skid control ECU
BC-70
C1381/97
Yaw Rate and / or
Acceleration Sensor
Power Supply Voltage
Malfunction
315
- Yaw rate (deceleration)
sensor circuit
- Harness and connector
- Skid control ECU
BC-70
1. Drive the vehicle at the vehicle speed of (50 km/h) 31 mph
and keep depressing the brake pedal strongly for
approximately 3 seconds.
2. Repeat the above operation 3 times or more and check
that the ABS warning light goes off.
3. Clear the DTC.
HINT:
In some cases, the intelligent tester cannot be used when
ABS warning light remains on.
DTC chart of Enhanced VSC
DTC No.
Detection Item
C1210/36
Zero Point Calibration of
Yaw Rate Sensor Undone
C1231/31
INF Code
Trouble Area
See page
336
- Zero point calibration
undone (Perform zero
point calibration and check
DTC. If DTC is not output
again, the sensor is
normal.)
BC-70
Steering Angle Sensor
Circuit Malfunction
341
342
343
344
345
346
347
348
349
- Steering angle sensor
- Skid control ECU
BC-75
C1232/32
Stuck in Acceleration
Sensor
311
312
- Yaw rate (deceleration)
sensor
- Skid control ECU
BC-70
C1234/34
Yaw Rate Sensor
Malfunction
331
332
333
334
335
337
- Yaw rate (deceleration)
sensor
BC-70
C1310/51
Malfunction in HV system
156
- Hybrid control system
(Enhanced VSC, TRAC
system)
BC-119
BC
BC–52
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
DTC No.
C1336/39
Detection Item
Zero Point Calibration of
Acceleration Sensor
Undone
INF Code
318
Trouble Area
See page
- Zero point calibration
undone (Perform zero
point calibration and check
DTC. If DTC is not output
again, the sensor is
normal.)
BC-70
DTC chart of ECB
Trouble Area
See page
C1202/68
DTC No.
Master Reservoir Level
Malfunction
Detection Item
511
512
- Brake fluid level
- Brake fluid level warning
switch
- Harness and connector
- Skid control ECU
BC-66
C1203/95
ECM Communication
Circuit Malfunction
-
- Skid control ECU
BC-69
C1241/41
Low Battery Positive
Voltage or Abnormally
High Battery Positive
Voltage
81
82
83
84
- ABS NO. 1 relay
- ABS NO. 2 relay
- Harness and connector
- Skid control power
supply circuit
- Brake control power
supply assembly
- Hybrid control system
BC-84
C1242/42
Open in IG1 / IG2 Power
Source Circuit
87
88
- ABS NO. 1 relay
- ABS NO. 2 relay
- Harness and connector
- Skid control power
supply circuit
- Brake control power
supply assembly
- Hybrid control system
BC-84
C1246/46
Master Cylinder Pressure
Sensor Malfunction
191
192
194
195
197
198
199
200
201
202
205
- Brake actuator assembly
- Skid control ECU
- Harness and connector
BC-92
C1247/47
Stroke Sensor Malfunction
171
172
173
174
175
176
177
179
180
- Brake pedal stroke
sensor
- Skid control ECU
- Harness and connector
BC-99
C1249/49
Open in Stop Light Switch
Circuit
520
- Stop light switch
- Stop light switch control
- Stop light bulb
BC-104
C1252/52
Brake Booster Pump
Motor on Time Abnormally
Long
130
- Brake actuator assembly
BC-109
C1253/53
Hydro Booster Pump
Motor Relay Malfunction
132
133
134
136
137
138
140
- ABS MTR relay
- ABS MTR 2 relay
- Harness and connector
- Brake actuator assembly
BC-109
BC
INF Code
BC–53
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
Trouble Area
See page
C1256/57
DTC No.
Accumulator Low
Pressure
141
143
- Brake actuator assembly
(accumulator pressure,
accumulator pressure
sensor, pump motor)
BC-117
C1259/58
HV System Regenerative
Malfunction
150
- Hybrid control system
BC-119
Skid Control ECU
Malfunction
-
- Skid control ECU
BC-121
C1311/11
Open in Main Relay 1
Circuit
1
- ABS NO. 1 relay
- Skid control ECU
- Harness and connector
BC-122
C1312/12
Short in Main Relay 1
Circuit
3
- ABS NO. 1 relay
- Skid control ECU
- Harness and connector
BC-122
C1313/13
Open in Main Relay 2
Circuit
4
- ABS NO. 2 relay
- Skid control ECU
- Harness and connector
BC-122
C1314/14
Short in Main Relay 2
Circuit
6
- ABS NO. 2 relay
- Skid control ECU
- Harness and connector
BC-122
C1315/31
SMC1 Changeover
Solenoid Malfunction
61
62
63
64
- Brake actuator assembly
(SMC1)
- Skid control ECU
- Harness and connector
BC-129
C1316/32
SMC2 Changeover
Solenoid Malfunction
66
67
68
69
- Brake actuator assembly
(SMC2)
- Skid control ECU
- Harness and connector
BC-129
C1319/35
SCSS Changeover
Solenoid Malfunction
71
72
73
74
- Stroke simulator
- Skid control ECU
- Harness and connector
BC-137
C1341/62
Front Hydraulic System
RH Malfunction
551
552
553
554
555
- Fluid leakage
- Brake actuator assembly
- Disc rotor
BC-141
C1342/63
Front Hydraulic System
LH Malfunction
561
562
563
564
565
- Fluid leakage
- Brake actuator assembly
- Disc rotor
BC-141
C1343/64
Rear Hydraulic System
RH Malfunction
571
572
573
574
575
- Fluid leakage
- Brake actuator assembly
- Disc rotor
BC-141
C1344/65
Rear Hydraulic System LH
Malfunction
581
582
583
584
585
- Fluid leakage
- Brake actuator assembly
- Disc rotor
BC-141
C1345/66
Linear Solenoid Valve
Offset Learning Undone
501
502
503
504
- Initialization of linear
solenoid valve and
calibration undone
BC-149
C1352/21
Front Increasing Pressure
Solenoid RH Malfunction
11
12
13
14
- Brake actuator assembly
- Skid control ECU
- Harness and connector
BC-129
C1300
Detection Item
INF Code
BC
BC–54
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
See page
C1353/23
Front Increasing Pressure
Solenoid LH Malfunction
21
22
23
24
- Brake actuator assembly
- Skid control ECU
- Harness and connector
BC-129
C1354/25
Rear Increasing Pressure
Solenoid RH Malfunction
31
32
33
34
- Brake actuator assembly
- Skid control ECU
- Harness and connector
BC-129
C1355/27
Rear Increasing Pressure
Solenoid LH Malfunction
41
42
43
44
- Brake actuator assembly
- Skid control ECU
- Harness and connector
BC-129
C1356/22
Front Decreasing
Pressure Solenoid RH
Malfunction
16
17
18
19
- Brake actuator assembly
- Skid control ECU
- Harness and connector
BC-129
C1357/24
Front Decreasing
Pressure Solenoid LH
Malfunction
26
27
28
29
- Brake actuator assembly
- Skid control ECU
- Harness and connector
BC-129
C1358/26
Rear Decreasing Pressure
Solenoid RH Malfunction
36
37
38
39
- Brake actuator assembly
- Skid control ECU
- Harness and connector
BC-129
C1359/28
Rear Decreasing Pressure
Solenoid LH Malfunction
46
47
48
49
- Brake actuator assembly
- Skid control ECU
- Harness and connector
BC-129
C1364/61
Wheel Cylinder Pressure
Sensor Malfunction
221
222
224
225
226
227
228
230
231
232
233
234
236
237
238
239
240
242
243
244
- Brake actuator assembly
- Skid control ECU
- Harness and connector
BC-92
C1365/54
Accumulator Pressure
Sensor Malfunction
211
212
214
215
216
- Brake actuator assembly
(accumulator pressure
sensor)
- Skid control ECU
BC-150
C1368/67
Linear Solenoid Valve
Offset Malfunction
505
- Initialization of linear
solenoid valve and
calibration undone
- Skid control ECU
BC-149
BC
INF Code
BC–55
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
DTC No.
Detection Item
INF Code
Trouble Area
See page
C1377/43
Capacitor Malfunction
101
102
103
105
106
108
109
110
113
- Brake control power
supply
- Harness and connector
- ABS MAIN1 fuse
- ABS MAIN2 fuse
- ABS MAIN3 fuse
- Apply high voltage
BC-154
C1378/44
Capacitor Communication
Malfunction
112
- Harness and connector
- Skid control ECU
BC-160
C1391/69
Accumulator Leak
Malfunction
591
- Fluid leakage
- Brake actuator assembly
BC-164
C1392/48
Stroke Sensor Zero Point
Calibration Undone
-
- Brake pedal stroke
sensor zero point
calibration undone
(initialization of linear
solenoid valve and
calibration undone)
- Skid control ECU
BC-99
DTC of test mode
DTC No.
Detection Item
INF Code
Trouble Area
See page
C0371/71
Yaw Rate Sensor (Test
Mode DTC)
Yaw rate sensor
(Deceleration sensor)
BC-70
C1271/71
Low Output Signal of Front
Speed Sensor RH (Test
Mode DTC)
- Right front speed sensor
- Speed sensor circuit
- Sensor installation
- Sensor rotor
BC-54
C1272/72
Low Output Signal of Front
Speed Sensor LH (Test
Mode DTC)
- Left front speed sensor
- Speed sensor circuit
- Sensor installation
- Sensor rotor
BC-54
C1273/73
Low Output Signal of Rear
Speed Sensor RH (Test
Mode DTC)
- Right rear speed sensor
- Speed sensor circuit
- Sensor installation
- Sensor rotor
BC-61
C1274/74
Low Output Signal of Rear
Speed Sensor LH (Test
Mode DTC)
- Left rear speed sensor
- Speed sensor circuit
- Sensor installation
- Sensor rotor
BC-61
C1275/75
Abnormal Change in
Output Signal of Front
Speed Sensor RH (Test
Mode DTC)
- Right front speed sensor
- Speed sensor circuit
- Sensor installation
BC-79
C1276/76
Abnormal Change in
Output Signal of Front
Speed Sensor LH (Test
Mode DTC)
- Left front speed sensor
- Speed sensor circuit
- Sensor installation
BC-79
C1277/77
Abnormal Change in
Output Signal of Rear
Speed Sensor RH (Test
Mode DTC)
- Right rear speed sensor
- Speed sensor circuit
- Sensor installation
BC-79
C1278/78
Abnormal Change in
Output Signal of Rear
Speed Sensor LH (Test
Mode DTC)
- Left rear speed sensor
- Speed sensor circuit
- Sensor installation
BC-79
C1279/79
Acceleration Sensor
Output Voltage
Malfunction (Test Mode
DTC)
- Yaw rate (deceleration)
sensor
- Yaw rate (deceleration)
sensor circuit
BC-70
BC
BC–56
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
DTC No.
Detection Item
C1281/81
Master Cylinder Pressure
Sensor Output Malfunction
(Test Mode DTC)
INF Code
Trouble Area
See page
- Brake actuator assembly
- Skid control ECU
BC-92
HINT:
The codes in this table are output only in test mode.
BC
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
BC–57
DTC
C0200/31 Front Speed Sensor RH Circuit
DTC
C0205/32 Front Speed Sensor LH Circuit
DTC
C1271/71
Low Output Signal of Front Speed Sensor RH
(Test Mode DTC)
DTC
C1272/72
Low Output Signal of Front Speed Sensor LH
(Test Mode DTC)
DESCRIPTION
The speed sensor detects wheel speed and sends the appropriate signals to the ECU. These signals are
used to control the ABS control system. The front and rear rotors have 48 serrations, respectively.
When the rotors rotate, the magnetic field emitted by the permanent magnet in the speed sensor
generates an AC voltage. Since the frequency of this AC voltage changes in direct proportion to the speed
of the rotor, the frequency is used by the ECU to detect the speed of each wheel.
DTCs C1271/71 and C1272/72 can be deleted when the speed sensor sends a vehicle speed signal or
the Test Mode ends. DTCs C1271/71 and C1272/72 are output only in the test mode.
Speed Sensor
Rotor
Coil
N
S
Magnet
To ECU
Low Speed
High Speed
+V
-V
F000010E05
BC
BC–58
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C0200/31
251
252
253
254
255
256
257
258
259
260
261
262
When one of following conditions
is met:
• Speed of a malfunctioning
wheel is 0 km/h (0 mph) for at
least 15 sec. when vehicle
speed is 10 km/h (6 mph) or
more.
• Speed of the slowest wheel is
less than 1/7th of the 2nd
slowest wheel for at least 15
sec. when vehicle speed is 10
km/h (6 mph) or more.
• Abnormal high wheel speed
pulse is input for at least 15
sec.
• Abnormal high wheel speed
pulse is input at least 7 times
when ECU is on.
• Speed sensor pulse signal is
instantly cut 7 times or more.
• Speed sensor signal line is
open for at least 0.5 sec.
•
264
265
266
267
268
269
270
271
272
273
274
275
When one of following conditions
is met:
• Speed of a malfunctioning
wheel is 0 km/h (0 mph) for at
least 15 sec. when vehicle
speed is 10 km/h (6 mph) or
more.
• Speed of the slowest wheel is
less than 1/7th of the 2nd
slowest wheel for at least 15
sec. when vehicle speed is 10
km/h (6 mph) or more.
• Abnormal high wheel speed
pulse is input for at least 15
sec.
• Abnormal high wheel speed
pulse is input at least 7 times
when ECU is on.
• Speed sensor pulse signal is
instantly cut 7 times or more.
• Speed sensor signal line is
open for at least 0.5 sec.
•
•
•
•
Right front and left front
speed sensor
Each speed sensor circuit
Sensor rotor
Sensor installation
-
Detected only during test mode.
•
•
•
•
Front speed sensor
Front speed sensor circuit
Sensor rotor
Sensor installation
C0205/32
C1271/71
C1272/72
BC
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
•
•
•
Right front and left front
speed sensor
Each speed sensor circuit
Sensor rotor
Sensor installation
HINT:
• DTC C0200/31 is for the right front speed sensor.
• DTC C0205/32 is for the left front speed sensor.
• The BRAKE warning light comes on when speed sensor malfunctions are detected in 2 or more
wheels.
BC–59
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Skid Control ECU
(Shielded)
ABS Speed Sensor Front RH
FRFR+
FSS
(Shielded)
ABS Speed Sensor Front LH
FLFR+
C126244E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the skid control ECU, perform initialization of linear solenoid valve and calibration
(see page BC-19).
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (MOMENTARY INTERRUPTION)
(a) Using the intelligent tester, check for any momentary
interruption in the wire harness and connector
corresponding to a DTC (see page BC-17).
Skid control ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
SPD SEN FR
FR speed sensor open detection /
OPEN or NORMAL
NORMAL: Normal condition
-
SPD SEN FL
FL speed sensor open detection /
OPEN or NORMAL
NORMAL: Normal condition
-
OK:
There are no momentary interruptions.
HINT:
Perform the above inspection before removing the
sensor and connector.
NG
OK
Go to step 5
BC
BC–60
2
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (FRONT SPEED SENSOR)
(a) Check the DATA LIST for proper functioning of the front
speed sensor.
Skid control ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
WHEEL SPD FR
Wheel speed sensor (FR) reading
/ min.: 0 km/h (0 mph), max.: 326
km/h (202 mph)
Actual wheel speed
Similar speed as indicated on
speedometer
WHEEL SPD FL
Wheel speed sensor (FL) reading
/ min.: 0 km/h (0 mph), max.: 326
km/h (202 mph)
Actual wheel speed
Similar speed as indicated on
speedometer
OK:
There is almost no difference from the displayed
speed value.
HINT:
There is tolerance of +-10% in the speedometer
indication.
NG
Go to step 4
OK
3
CHECK SPEED SENSOR AND SENSOR ROTOR SERRATIONS
Normal Signal Waveform
GND
1 V/DIV.
2 msec./DIV.
F100551E08
BC
OK
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
(a) Connect the oscilloscope to terminal FR+ and FR-, or
FL+ and FL- of the skid control ECU.
(b) Drive the vehicle at approximately 30 km/h (19 mph),
and check the signal waveform.
OK:
A waveform as shown should be output.
HINT:
• As the vehicle speed (wheel revolution speed)
increases, a cycle of the waveform narrows and the
fluctuation in the output voltage becomes greater.
• When noise is identified in the waveform on the
oscilloscope, error signals are generated due to the
speed sensor rotor's scratches, looseness or foreign
matter deposited on it.
NG
Go to step 6
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
4
BC–61
INSPECT FRONT SPEED SENSOR
2
(a) Disconnect the speed sensor connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the sensors.
Standard resistance:
for LH
1
C093876E12
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
2 (FL+) - 1 (FL-)
1.4 to 1.8 kΩ
1 (FL-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
2 (FL+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
for RH
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
2 (FR+) - 1 (FR-)
1.4 to 1.8 kΩ
1 (FR-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
2 (FR+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NOTICE:
Check the speed sensor signal after replacement
(see page BC-23).
NG
REPLACE FRONT SPEED SENSOR
OK
BC
BC–62
5
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SKID CONTROL ECU - FRONT SPEED SENSOR)
(a) Disconnect the S7 and S10 ECU connectors.
(b) Disconnect the A3 and A4 sensor connectors.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance:
for LH
Wire Harness Side
Skid Control ECU
Tester Connection
S7
S10
Specified Condition
A3-1 (FL-) - S10-22 (FL-)
Below 1 Ω
A3-2 (FL+) - S10-28 (FL+)
Below 1 Ω
A3-2 (FL+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A3-1 (FL-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
for RH
FR-
FL-
FR+
FL+
Front Speed Sensor
LH
RH
A4
A3
FL+
FL-
FR+
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A4-1 (FR-) - S7-22 (FR-)
Below 1 Ω
A4-2 (FR+) - S7-32 (FR+)
Below 1 Ω
A4-2 (FR+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A4-1 (FR-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
FR-
C126271E01
OK
6
CHECK SPEED SENSOR AND SENSOR ROTOR SERRATIONS
Normal Signal Waveform
BC
GND
1 V/DIV.
2 msec./DIV.
F100551E09
(a) Connect the oscilloscope to terminals FR+ and FR-, or
FL+ and FL- of the skid control ECU.
(b) Drive the vehicle at approximately 30 km/h (19 mph),
and check the signal waveform.
OK:
A waveform as shown should be output.
HINT:
• As the vehicle speed (wheel revolution speed)
increases, a cycle of the waveform narrows and the
fluctuation in the output voltage becomes greater.
• When noise is identified in the waveform on the
oscilloscope, error signals are generated due to the
speed sensor rotor's scratches, looseness or foreign
matter deposited on it.
NG
Go to step 7
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
BC–63
OK
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
7
INSPECT FRONT SPEED SENSOR INSTALLATION
(a) Check the speed sensor installation.
OK:
The installation bolt is tightened properly and there
is no clearance between the sensor and front
steering knuckle.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Check the speed sensor signal after the replacement
(see page BC-23).
8.0 N*m
No Clearance
OK
NG
C108871E01
NG
REPLACE FRONT SPEED SENSOR
OK
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
BC
BC–64
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
DTC
C0210/33 Rear Speed Sensor RH Circuit
DTC
C0215/34 Rear Speed Sensor LH Circuit
DTC
C1273/73
Low Output Signal of Rear Speed Sensor RH
(Test Mode DTC)
DTC
C1274/74
Low Output Signal of Rear Speed Sensor LH
(Test Mode DTC)
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC C0200/31 and C0205/32 (see page BC-54).
DTCs C1273/73 and C1274/74 can be deleted when the speed sensor sends a vehicle speed signal or
the Test Mode ends. DTCs C1273/73 and C1274/74 are output only in the Test Mode.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C0210/33
277
278
279
280
281
282
283
284
285
286
287
288
When one of following conditions
is met:
• Speed of a malfunctioning
wheel is 0 mph (0 km/h) for at
least 15 sec. when vehicle
speed is 6 mph (10 km/h) or
more.
• Speed of the slowest wheel is
less than 1/7th of the 2nd
slowest wheel for at least 15
sec. when vehicle speed is 6
mph (10 km/h) or more.
• Abnormal high wheel speed
pulse is input for at least 15
sec.
• Abnormal high wheel speed
pulse is input at least 7 times
when ECU is on.
• Speed sensor pulse signal is
instantly cut 7 times or more.
• Speed sensor signal line is
open for at least 0.5 sec.
•
290
291
292
293
294
295
296
297
298
299
300
301
When one of following conditions
is met:
• Speed of a malfunctioning
wheel is 0 mph (0 km/h) for at
least 15 sec. when vehicle
speed is 6 mph (10 km/h) or
more.
• Speed of the slowest wheel is
less than 1/7th of the 2nd
slowest wheel for at least 15
sec. when vehicle speed is 6
mph (10 km/h) or more.
• Abnormal high wheel speed
pulse is input for at least 15
sec.
• Abnormal high wheel speed
pulse is input at least 7 times
when ECU is on.
• Speed sensor pulse signal is
instantly cut 7 times or more.
• Speed sensor signal line is
open for at least 0.5 sec.
•
C0215/34
BC
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Right rear and left rear speed
sensor
Each speed sensor circuit
Sensor rotor
Sensor installation
Skid control ECU
Right rear and left rear speed
sensor
Each speed sensor circuit
Sensor rotor
Sensor installation
Skid control ECU
BC–65
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C1273/73
C1274/74
-
Detected only during test mode
•
•
•
•
Rear speed sensor
Rear speed sensor circuit
Sensor rotor
Sensor installation
HINT:
• DTC C0210/33 is for the right rear speed sensor.
• DTC C0215/34 is for the left rear speed sensor.
• The BRAKE warning light comes on when speed sensor malfunctions are detected in two or more
wheels.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Skid Control ECU
(Shielded)
ABS Speed Sensor Rear RH
RRRR+
RSS
(Shielded)
ABS Speed Sensor Rear LH
RLRR+
C126244E02
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the skid control ECU, perform initialization of linear solenoid valve and calibration
(see page BC-19).
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (MOMENTARY INTERRUPTION)
(a) Using the intelligent tester, check for any momentary
interruption in the wire harness and connector
corresponding to a DTC (see page BC-17).
Skid control ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
SPD SEN RR
RR speed sensor open detection
/ OPEN or NORMAL
NORMAL: Normal condition
-
SPD SEN RL
RL speed sensor open detection /
OPEN or NORMAL
NORMAL: Normal condition
-
BC
BC–66
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
OK:
There are no momentary interruption.
HINT:
Perform the above inspection before removing the
sensor and connector.
NG
Go to step 5
OK
2
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (REAR SPEED SENSOR)
(a) Check the DATA LIST for proper functioning of the rear
speed sensor.
Skid control ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
WHEEL SPD RL
Wheel speed sensor (RL) reading
/ min.: 0 km/h (0 mph), max.: 326
km/h (202 mph)
Actual wheel speed
Similar speed as indicated on
speedometer
WHEEL SPD RR
Wheel speed sensor (RR)
reading / min.: 0 km/h (0 mph),
max.: 326 km/h (202 mph)
Actual wheel speed
Similar speed as indicated on
speedometer
OK:
There is almost no difference in the displayed
speed value.
HINT:
There is tolerance of +-10% in the speedometer
indication.
NG
Go to step 4
OK
3
INSPECT SPEED SENSOR AND SENSOR ROTOR SERRATIONS
Normal Signal Waveform
BC
GND
1 V/DIV.
2 msec./DIV.
F100551E10
(a) Connect the oscilloscope to terminals RR+ and RR-, or
RL+ and RL- of the skid control ECU.
(b) Drive the vehicle at approximately 30 km/h (19 mph),
and check the signal waveform.
OK:
A waveform as shown should be output.
HINT:
• As the vehicle speed (wheel revolution speed)
increases, a cycle of the waveform narrows and the
fluctuation in the output voltage becomes greater.
• When noise is identified in the waveform on the
oscilloscope, error signals are generated due to the
speed sensor rotor's scratches, looseness or foreign
matter deposited on it.
NG
Go to step 7
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
BC–67
OK
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
4
INSPECT REAR SPEED SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the rear speed sensor connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the sensor.
Standard resistance
1
2
F041836E21
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1-2
1.04 to 1.30 kΩ
1 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
2 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPLACE REAR SPEED SENSOR
OK
5
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SKID CONTROL ECU - REAR SPEED SENSOR)
(a) Disconnect the S8 and S9 ECU connectors.
(b) Disconnect the A25 and A26 sensor connectors.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance:
for LH
Wire Harness Side
Skid Control ECU
S8
S9
RL-
RR-
RL+
RR+
Rear Speed Sensor
RH
LH
A26
A25
RL+
RL-
RR+
Specified Condition
A25-1 (RL+) - S8-35 (RL+)
Below 1 Ω
A25-2 (RL-) - S8-27 (RL-)
Below 1 Ω
A25-1 (RL+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A25-2 (RL-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
for RH
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A26-1 (RR+) - S9-31 (RR+)
Below 1 Ω
A26-2 (RR-) - S9-23 (RR-)
Below 1 Ω
A26-1 (RR+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A26-2 (RR-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
RRC126272E01
OK
Tester Connection
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
BC
BC–68
6
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
INSPECT SPEED SENSOR AND SENSOR ROTOR SERRATIONS
Normal Signal Waveform
GND
1 V/DIV.
2 msec./DIV.
F100551E11
(a) Connect the oscilloscope to terminals RR+ and RR-, or
RL+ and RL- of the skid control ECU.
(b) Drive the vehicle at approximately 30 km/h (19 mph),
and check the signal waveform.
OK:
A waveform as shown should be output.
HINT:
• As vehicle speed (wheel revolution speed) increases,
a cycle of the waveform narrows and the fluctuation in
the output voltage becomes greater.
• When noise is identified in the waveform on the
oscilloscope, error signals are generated due to the
speed sensor rotor's scratches, looseness or foreign
matter deposited on it.
NG
Go to step 7
OK
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
7
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
(a) Check the sensor installation.
OK:
There is no clearance between the sensor and rear
axle carrier.
NOTICE:
Check the speed sensor signal after the replacement
(see page BC-23).
Rear Speed Sensor
No Clearance
OK
NG
NG
F010178E20
OK
BC
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
REPLACE REAR SPEED SENSOR
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
DTC
BC–69
C1202/68 Master Reservoir Level Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
When a fluid level drop in the master cylinder reservoir is detected, the signal is input to the skid control
ECU. When the DTC for the fluid level drop is memorized, the warning is canceled if the fluid level returns
to normal and the other DTCs are not input.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C1202/68
511
When either condition below is
met:
• Pump motor operates for
specified period when
reservoir level drops
• Brake operation signal is
input when the reservoir level
is abnormal and the power
switch is on.
•
•
•
•
Brake fluid level
Brake fluid level warning
switch
Harness and connector
Skid control ECU
Open in switch signal circuit
continues for 2 seconds or more.
•
•
•
Brake fluid level switch
Harness and connector
Skid control ECU
C1202/68
512
WIRING DIAGRAM
Skid Control ECU
LBL
Brake Fluid Level
Warning Switch
C126245E01
BC
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the skid control ECU, perform initialization of linear solenoid valve and calibration
(see page BC-19).
HINT:
When releasing the parking brake, set wheel chocks to hold the vehicle for safety.
1
CHECK BRAKE FLUID LEVEL IN RESERVOIR
(a) Check that the brake fluid level is sufficient.
BC–70
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
HINT:
• If the fluid level drops, check for a fluid leak, and
repair if found.
• If no leaks exist, add and adjust fluid and then check
that the trouble code is not output again.
OK:
Brake fluid level is proper.
NG
ADD BRAKE FLUID
OK
2
INSPECT BRAKE FLUID LEVEL WARNING SWITCH
(a) Remove the reservoir tank cap and strainer.
(b) Disconnect the brake fluid level warning switch
connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the switch.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Fluid Level
Specified Condition
1-2
Proper
1.8 to 2.16 kΩ
1-2
Below minimum level
Below 1 Ω
G026237E07
NG
REPLACE BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER
RESERVOIR SUB-ASSEMBLY
OK
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SKID CONTROL ECU - BRAKE FLUID LEVEL WARNING
SWITCH)
(a) Disconnect the S10 ECU connector.
(b) Disconnect the B1 switch connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Skid Control ECU
S10
LBL
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S10-6 (LBL) - B1-2
Below 1 Ω
S10-6 (LBL) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
BC
Brake Fluid Level Warning Switch
B1
C126273E01
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
BC–71
OK
4
RECONFIRM DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (see page BC-38).
(b) Turn the power switch ON (READY).
(c) Check that the same DTCs are recorded (see page BC38).
HINT:
This DTC may be memorized due to a malfunction in the
connector terminal connection, etc.
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC is output
A
DTC is not output
B
B
END
A
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
BC
BC–72
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
DTC
C1203/95 ECM Communication Circuit Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C1203/95
-
When one of following conditions
is met:
• No stored information for
destination.
• No stored information
whether VSC is in operation
or not.
• Destination information from
HV-ECU does not match with
stored value.
Skid control ECU
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the skid control ECU, perform initialization of linear solenoid valve and calibration
(see page BC-19).
1
CHECK DTC (HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM)
(a) Check if a hybrid control system DTC is output (see page
HV-55).
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC is not output
A
DTC is output
B
B
REPAIR HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
A
2
CHECK DTC (ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM)
(a) Check if C1300/- is output.
Result
BC
Result
Proceed to
C1300/- is not output
A
C1300/- is output
B
B
A
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
GO TO DTC C1300
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
BC–73
Zero Point Calibration of Yaw Rate Sensor
Undone
DTC
C1210/36
DTC
C0371/71 Yaw Rate Sensor (Test Mode DTC)
DTC
C1232/32 Stuck in Acceleration Sensor
DTC
C1234/34 Yaw Rate Sensor Malfunction
DTC
C1243/43 Acceleration Sensor Stuck Malfunction
DTC
C1244/44 Open or Short in Acceleration Sensor Circuit
DTC
C1245/45 Acceleration Sensor Output Malfunction
DTC
C1279/79
Acceleration Sensor Output Voltage Malfunction (Test Mode DTC)
DTC
C1336/39
Zero Point Calibration of Acceleration Sensor
Undone
DTC
C1381/97
Yaw Rate and / or Acceleration Sensor Power
Supply Voltage Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The yaw rate (deceleration) sensor detects any gravity applied to the vehicle and transmit the signal to the
skid control ECU via CAN communication system (vehicle equipped with Enhanced VSC). The
deceleration sensor is built into the yaw rate sensor and detects the vehicle condition in the 2 systems
(GL1, GL2).
When a malfunction occurs in the communication line with the yaw rate sensor, DTC U0123/62 (yaw rate
sensor communication malfunction) and DTC U0124/95 (deceleration sensor communication malfunction)
are output.
DTCs C0371/71 and C1279/79 are deleted when the yaw rate and deceleration sensor sends a yaw rate
and/or deceleration signal or test mode ends. DTCs C0371/71 and C1279/79 are output only in test
mode.
DTC No.
NF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C1210/36
336
Yaw rate sensor zero point
calibration is unfinished.
Zero point calibration undone
(Perform zero point calibration
and check DTC. If DTC is not
output again, the sensor is
normal.)
C0731/71
-
Detected only during test mode
•
•
Yaw rate (deceleration)
sensor
Yaw rate (deceleration)
sensor circuit
BC
BC–74
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
DTC No.
NF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C1232/32
311
312
One GL1/2 signal fluctuation is
within 80 mV and the other is 1.9
V or more for at least 30 sec.
when vehicle speed is 10 km/h (6
mph)
•
•
C1234/34
331
332
333
334
335
337
Signal of malfunction that is
detected at sensor self-check is
received when communication
with the sensors is valid.
Yaw rate (deceleration) sensor
C1243/43
317
Sensor sticking can be seen 16
times or more in a series at a
speed between 30 km/h (18 mph)
and 0 km/h (0 mph).
•
Difference between GL1 and GL2
is not less than 0.4 G for at least
60 sec. after the difference is 0.6
G or more when the vehicle
speed is 0 km/h (0 mph).
Malfunction signal from
deceleration sensor is received.
•
Difference between the G value
calculated from deceleration
sensor value and vehicle speed
exceeds 0.35 G for at least 60
sec. when vehicle speed is 30
km/h (18 mph).
•
C1244/44
C1245/45
314
313
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
C1279/79
-
Detected only during test mode
•
•
BC
Yaw rate (deceleration)
sensor
Skid control ECU
Yaw rate (deceleration)
sensor
Skid control ECU
Yaw rate (deceleration)
sensor
Yaw rate (deceleration)
sensor installation
Zero point calibration not
done
Skid control ECU
Yaw rate (deceleration)
sensor
Yaw rate (deceleration)
sensor installation
Zero point calibration not
done
Skid control ECU
Yaw rate (deceleration)
sensor
Yaw rate (deceleration)
sensor circuit
C1336/39
318
Vehicle speed increases with
unfinished zero point calibration.
Zero point calculation is not within
specified range when zero point
calibration is finished.
Zero point calibration undone
(Perform zero point calibration
and check DTC. If DTC is not
output again, the sensor is
normal.)
C1381/97
315
Power source voltage is not
within specified range when
communication between skid
control ECU and sensor is valid.
•
•
•
Yaw rate (deceleration)
sensor circuit
Harness and connector
Skid control ECU
BC–75
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Skid Control ECU
Gateway ECU
CAN1L
CAN-L
CAN1H
CAN-H
Yaw Rate (Deceleration) Sensor
Brake Control Power Supply
CANH
CANL
IG
IG
GND
BC
ABS MAIN3
MAIN
GND
BC
C126246E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (see page BC-38).
(b) Turn the power switch ON (READY).
BC–76
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
(c) Check that the trouble code for CAN communication
DTCs U0073/94 and U0123/62 are not output.
Result
Result
Proceed to
CAN communication DTCs are not
output.
A
CAN communication DTC U0073 or
U0123/62 is output.
B
Only unfinished zero point calibration
DTC C1210/36 or C1336/36 is output.
C
B
REPAIR CIRCUIT INDICATED BY OUTPUT
CODE
C
Go to step 5
A
2
CHECK SENSOR INSTALLATION (YAW RATE (DECELERATION) SENSOR)
(a) Check that the yaw rate (deceleration) sensor has been
installed properly.
OK:
The sensor should be tightened to the specified
torque.
The sensor should not be tilted.
NG
INSTALL YAW RATE SENSOR CORRECTLY
OK
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (YAW RATE SENSOR - BATTERY)
(a) Disconnect the Y1 sensor connector.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (READY).
(c) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
Y1
IG
BC
Specified Condition
Y1-5 (IG) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
NG
F045082E10
OK
Tester Connection
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
4
BC–77
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (YAW RATE SENSOR - BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the Y1 sensor connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Y1
GND
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Y1-1 (GND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
F045082E12
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE YAW RATE SENSOR
5
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION OF YAW RATE SENSOR AND DECELERATION
SENSOR
(a) Perform the zero point calibration of the yaw rate
(deceleration) sensor (see page BC-21).
NEXT
6
RECONFIRM DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (see page BC-38).
(b) Turn the power switch ON (READY).
(c) Check the same DTCs are recorded (see page BC-38).
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC is not output
A
DTC is output
B
HINT:
This DTC may be memorized due to a malfunction in the
connector terminal.
B
A
END
REPLACE YAW RATE SENSOR
BC
BC–78
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
DTC
C1231/31 Steering Angle Sensor Circuit Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The skid control ECU inputs the steering sensor signal through the CAN communication. When a
malfunction occurs in the communication line with the steering sensor, DTC U0126/63 (malfunction in
communication with steering angle sensor) is output.
BC
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C1231/31
341
342
343
344
345
346
347
348
349
When either condition below is
met:
• Steering angle sensor
malfunction signal is received
when data transmission is
valid (internal malfunction is
detected at sensor selfcheck).
• A signal of +B open in
steering angle sensor is
received when
communication with sensor is
valid.
•
•
Steering angle sensor
Skid control ECU
BC–79
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Steering Angle Sensor
Skid Control ECU
CAN-L
CAN-L
CAN-H
CAN-H
ECU-IG
Power Source Control ECU
IG1
AM1
AM1
IG1D
DOME
BAT
MAIN
DC/DC
ESS
C126247E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the skid control ECU, perform initialization of linear solenoid valve and calibration
(see page BC-19).
HINT:
• When U0126 is output together with C1231/31, inspect and repair the trouble areas indicated by
U0126/63 first.
• When the speed sensor or the yaw rate (deceleration) sensor has trouble, DTCs for the steering angle
sensor may be output even when the steering angle sensor is normal. When DTCs for the speed
sensor or yaw rate sensor are output together with other DTCs for the steering angle sensor, inspect
and repair the speed sensor and yaw rate (deceleration) sensor first, and then inspect and repair the
steering angle sensor.
BC
BC–80
1
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (MOMENTARY INTERRUPTION)
(a) Using the intelligent tester, check for any momentary
interruption in the wire harness and connectors between
the skid control ECU and steering angle sensor (see
page BC-17).
Skid control ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
STEERING SEN
Steering sensor open detection /
OPN-DET or NORMAL
NORMAL: Normal condition
-
OK:
There are no momentary interruptions.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
2
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (STEERING ANGLE SENSOR)
(a) Check the DATA LIST for proper functioning of the
steering angle sensor.
Skid control ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
STEERING ANG
Steering sensor /
Min.: -1152 deg, Max.: 1150.875
deg
Left turn: Increase
Right turn: Decrease
-
OK:
Steering angle value should change.
OK
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
NG
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (STEERING ANGLE SENSOR - BATTERY AND BODY GROUND)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Wire Harness Side
(-)
BC
(+)
BAT
S13
IG
(+)
(-)
ESS
Remove the steering wheel and the column lower cover.
Disconnect the S13 sensor connector.
Turn the power switch ON (READY).
Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S13-1 (IG) - S13-2 (ESS)
10 to 14 V
S13-3 (BAT) - S13-2 (ESS)
10 to 14 V
G026292E06
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
BC–81
OK
REPLACE STEERING ANGLE SENSOR
BC
BC–82
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
DTC
C1235/35
Foreign Object is Attached on Tip of Front
Speed Sensor RH
DTC
C1236/36
Foreign Object is Attached on Tip of Front
Speed Sensor LH
DTC
C1238/38
Foreign Object is Attached on Tip of Rear
Speed Sensor RH
DTC
C1239/39
Foreign Object is Attached on Tip of Rear
Speed Sensor LH
DTC
C1275/75
Abnormal Change in Output Signal of Front
Speed Sensor RH (Test Mode DTC)
DTC
C1276/76
Abnormal Change in Output Signal of Front
Speed Sensor LH (Test Mode DTC)
DTC
C1277/77
Abnormal Change in Output Signal of Rear
Speed Sensor RH (Test Mode DTC)
DTC
C1278/78
Abnormal Change in Output Signal of Rear
Speed Sensor LH (Test Mode DTC)
DESCRIPTION
High Speed
Low Speed
+V
Speed Sensor
BC
Rotor
N
S
Magnet
-V
Coil
To ECU
C108865E02
The speed sensor detects wheel speed and sends the appropriate signals to the ECU. These signals are
used to control the ABS control system. The front and rear rotors have 48 serrations respectively.
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
BC–83
When the rotors rotate, the magnetic field emitted by the permanent magnet in the speed sensor
generates an AC voltage. Since the frequency of this AC voltage changes in direct proportion to the speed
of the rotor, the frequency is used by the ECU to detect the speed of each wheel. When foreign matter
adheres to the speed sensor tip or sensor rotor, or the rotor teeth are chipped, these DTCs are output. An
abnormal waveform input from the sensor determines these conditions.
These DTCs may be detected when a malfunction occurs in the connector terminals or wire harness of
the speed sensor circuit.
DTCs C1275/75, C1276/76, C1277/77 and C1278/78 can be deleted when the speed sensor sends a
vehicle speed signal or the test mode ends. DTCs C1275/75, C1276/76, C1277/77 and C1278/78 are
output only in the test mode.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C1235/35
302
Pulse waveform of speed sensor
signal is abnormal for at least 5
sec. when vehicle speed is 20
km/h (12 mph) or more.
•
•
•
•
Right front speed sensor
Each speed sensor circuit
Sensor installation
Skid control ECU
C1236/36
303
Pulse waveform of speed sensor
signal is abnormal for at least 5
sec. when vehicle speed is 20
km/h (12 mph) or more.
•
•
•
•
Left front speed sensor
Each speed sensor circuit
Sensor installation
Skid control ECU
C1238/38
304
Pulse waveform of speed sensor
signal is abnormal for at least 5
sec. when vehicle speed is 20
km/h (12 mph) or more.
•
•
•
Right rear speed sensor
Each speed sensor circuit
Skid control ECU
C1239/39
305
Pulse waveform of speed sensor
signal is abnormal for at least 5
sec. when vehicle speed is 20
km/h (12 mph) or more.
•
•
•
Left rear speed sensor
Each speed sensor circuit
Skid control ECU
C1275/75
C1276/76
-
Detected only during test mode
•
•
•
Front speed sensor
Front speed sensor circuit
Sensor installation
C1275/77
C1276/78
-
Detected only during test mode
•
•
•
Rear speed sensor
Rear speed sensor circuit
Sensor installation
HINT:
• DTC C1235/35 is for the right front speed sensor.
• DTC C1236/36 is for the left front speed sensor.
• DTC C1238/38 is for the right rear speed sensor.
• DTC C1239/39 is for the left rear speed sensor.
BC
BC–84
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Skid Control ECU
ABS Speed Sensor Front RH
FRFR+
ABS Speed Sensor Front LH
FLFL+
ABS Speed Sensor Rear RH
RRRR+
ABS Speed Sensor Rear LH
RLRL+
C126248E01
BC
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
BC–85
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK SPEED SENSOR AND SENSOR ROTOR SERRATIONS
Normal Signal Waveform
GND
1 V/DIV.
2 msec./DIV.
(a) Connect the oscilloscope to terminal FR+ and FR-, or
FL+ and FL- of the skid control ECU.
(b) Drive the vehicle at approximately 30 km/h (19 mph),
and check the signal waveform.
OK:
A waveform as shown should be output.
• As the vehicle speed (wheel revolution speed)
increases, a cycle of the waveform narrows and the
fluctuation in the output voltage becomes greater.
• When noise is identified in the waveform on the
oscilloscope, error signals are generated due to the
speed sensor rotor's scratches, looseness or foreign
matter deposited on it.
NG
Go to step 4
F100551E12
OK
2
CHECK SPEED SENSOR AND SENSOR ROTOR SERRATIONS
GND
Change
F047503E01
(a) Connect the oscilloscope to terminal FR+ and FR-, or
FL+ and FL- of the skid control ECU.
(b) Check if the oscilloscope has any change when the wire
harness connector is subject to vibration while the
vehicle is stopped and the power switch is ON (IG). (If
the connector is poorly connected, vibration of the wire
harness connector may cause a temporary stop in
current flow.)
OK:
There is no change in a waveform.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
3
BC
RECONFIRM DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (see page BC-38 ).
(b) Turn the power switch ON (READY).
(c) Check the same DTCs are recorded (see page BC-38).
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC is not output
A
DTC is output
B
B
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
BC–86
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
A
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
4
INSPECT SPEED SENSOR TIP
(a) Remove the front axle hub and front speed sensor.
(b) Check the sensor tip.
OK:
No scratches or foreign matter on the sensor tip.
NOTICE:
Check the speed sensor signal after the replacement
(see page BC-23).
NG
CLEAN OR REPLACE SPEED SENSOR
OK
5
INSPECT SPEED SENSOR ROTOR
(a) Remove the front axle hub and front speed sensor rotor.
(b) Check the sensor rotor serrations.
OK:
No scratches, missing teeth or foreign matter on
the rotors.
HINT:
If there is foreign matter in the rotor, remove it and check
the output waveform after reassembly.
NOTICE:
Check the speed sensor signal after the replacement
(see page BC-23).
NG
OK
REPLACE SPEED SENSOR
BC
CLEAN OR REPLACE SPEED SENSOR
ROTOR
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
BC–87
Low Battery Positive Voltage or Abnormally
High Battery Positive Voltage
DTC
C1241/41
DTC
C1242/42 Open in IG1 / IG2 Power Source Circuit
DESCRIPTION
These codes are memorized when the power source voltage for the skid control ECU drops or the voltage
for the ABS NO. 1, ABS NO. 2 relay operation drops.
Codes may be memorized when the voltage of the auxiliary battery temporarily drops.
When the power source voltage is too high, the skid control ECU stops functioning and outputs no DTCs,
and the ABS and BRAKE warning light remain on.
HINT:
DTC C1256/56 (accumulator low voltage malfunction) may be memorized if the power source voltage
drops.
DTC No.
Detailed Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C1241/41
81
System 1 is under the following
conditions when READY is on:
• Linear solenoid cannot
receive enough current
(brake is applied).
• BS voltage is less than 8.9 V
for at least 3 sec. (brake is
not applied).
• 12 V-power source voltage
inside ECU is less than 8.5 V
when main relay is opened or
VCM voltage is less than 4.7
V or 5 V or more for at least
0.05 sec.
•
•
•
System 2 is under the following
conditions when READY is on:
• Linear solenoid cannot
receive enough current
(brake is applied).
• BS voltage is less than 8.9 V
for at least 3 sec. (brake is
not applied).
• 12 V-power source voltage
inside ECU is less than 8.5 V
when main relay is opened or
VCM voltage is less than 4.7
V or 5.3 V or more for at least
0.05 sec.
•
•
•
Capacitor mode signal is received
from brake control power supply
for 3 sec. or more when READY
is on.
•
•
•
Brake control power supply
assembly
Brake control power supply
Hybrid control system
C1241/41
C1241/41
82
83
•
•
•
•
ABS NO. 1 relay
Harness and connector
Skid control power supply
circuit
Brake control power supply
assembly
Hybrid control system
ABS NO. 2 relay
Harness and connector
Skid control power supply
circuit
Brake control power supply
assembly
Hybrid control system
C1241/41
84
ABS is requested to operate
when the power source voltage of
the main relay system is
dropping.
•
•
•
ABS NO. 1 relay
ABS NO. 2 relay
Harness and connector
C1242/42
87
Voltage is applied to IG2 terminal,
but not applied to IG1 terminal for
at least 4 sec.
•
•
•
ABS NO. 1 relay
Harness and connector
Skid control power supply
circuit
Brake control power supply
assembly
Hybrid control system
•
•
BC
BC–88
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
DTC No.
Detailed Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C1242/42
88
Voltage is applied to IG1 terminal,
but not applied to IG2 terminal for
at least 4 sec.
•
•
•
•
•
BC
ABS NO. 2 relay
Harness and connector
Skid control power supply
circuit
Brake control power supply
assembly
Hybrid control system
BC–89
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Skid Control ECU
Brake Actuator
SMC1
SMC1
SMC2
SMC2
BS2
R2+
ABS NO. 2
SR2
BS1
ABS NO. 1
BSR
BDSS
SR1
Brake Master Stroke Simulator
Cylinder Assembly
R1+
BS1
SCSS
+BI1
+BI2
BC1
IG
OUT2
+BO2
OUT1
+BO1
BCTY
IG1
Brake Control Power Supply
A B C D E
BC
+BCTY
BCTY
F
C126249E01
BC–90
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
F
A B C D E
ECU-IG
IG1
AM1
IG2
AM2
IG2D
P/I
AM2
AM1
IG1D
Power Source
Control ECU
DC/DC
ABS MAIN3
BC
ABS MAIN2
ABS MAIN1
A
B C
D
E
C126250E01
BC–91
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
A
B
C D
E
IGN
IG2
GND1
GND2
GND3
GND4
GND5
MAIN
GND6
GND1
GND2
Door Courtesy
Switch Front LH
C126251E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
BC
CHECK DTC (HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM)
(a) Check that hybrid control system DTCs are output.
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC is not output
A
DTC is output
B
B
A
REPAIR HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
BC–92
2
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
CHECK AUXILIARY BATTERY VOLTAGE
(a) Check the auxiliary battery voltage.
Standard voltage:
10 to 14 V
NG
CHARGE OR REPLACE AUXILIARY
BATTERY
OK
3
CHECK BRAKE CONTROL POWER SUPPLY (IG VOLTAGE)
(a) Measure the voltage of the connector.
Standard voltage
IG
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
B18-5 (IG) - Body
ground
Power switch ON
(READY)
10 to 14 V
NG
B18
REPLACE BRAKE CONTROL POWER
SUPPLY
F047500E01
OK
4
CHECK SKID CONTROL ECU
GND2
IG1
GND1
S7
GND3
+BI2
+BI1
S8
S9
GND4
GND5 IG2
GND6
S10
F047485E54
BC
(a) Measure the voltage of the connectors.
HINT:
Measure the voltage from behind the connector with the
connector connected to the skid control ECU.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
S8-7 (IG1) - Body
ground
Power switch ON
(READY)
10 to 14 V
S10-5 (IG2) - Body
ground
Power switch ON
(READY)
10 to 14 V
S8-3 (+BI1) - Body
ground
Always
10 to 14 V
S9-5 (+BI2) - Body
ground
Always
10 to 14 V
(b) Measure the resistance of the connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S7-1 (GND1) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
S8-2 (GND2) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
S8-1 (GND3) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
S9-2 (GND4) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
S9-1 (GND5) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
S10-4 (GND6) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
NG
BC–93
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
5
CHECK SKID CONTROL ECU (BS1, R1+, SR1, BS2, R2+, DSR2 VOLTAGE)
BS1
R1+
SR2
S7
BS2
R2+
SR2
S10
F047485E55
(a) Measure the voltage of the connectors.
HINT:
Measure the voltage from behind the connector with the
connector connected to the skid control ECU.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
S7-2 (R1+) - Body
ground
Power switch ON
(READY)
8 to 13 V
S10-17 (R2+) - Body
ground
Power switch ON
(READY)
8 to 13 V
S7-12 (SR1) - Body
ground
Power switch ON
(READY)
Below 1.5 V
S10-15 (SR2) - Body
ground
Power switch ON
(READY)
Below 1.5 V
S7-3 (BS1) - Body
ground
Power switch ON
(READY)
10 to 14 V
S10-7 (BS2) - Body
ground
Power switch ON
(READY)
10 to 14 V
Result
Result
Proceed to
All OK
A
NG (R1+, R2+)
B
NG (SR1, SR2, BS1, BS2)
C
B
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
C
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
A
6
RECONFIRM DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (see page BC-38 ).
(b) Turn the power switch ON (READY).
(c) Check the same DTCs are recorded (see page BC-38).
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC is not output
A
DTC is output
B
B
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
BC
BC–94
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
A
END (DTC MAY BE STORED DUE TO TEMPORARY POWER SOURCE VOLTAGE DROP)
BC
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
BC–95
DTC
C1246/46 Master Cylinder Pressure Sensor Malfunction
DTC
C1281/81
DTC
C1364/61 Wheel Cylinder Pressure Sensor Malfunction
Master Cylinder Pressure Sensor Output Malfunction (Test Mode DTC)
DESCRIPTION
The master cylinder pressure sensor and the wheel cylinder pressure sensor are built into the brake
actuator, and measure the master cylinder pressure and the wheel cylinder pressure sent to the skid
control ECU.
DTC C1281/81 can be detected when the master cylinder pressure sensor sends a master cylinder
pressure signal or test mode ends. DTC C1281/81 is output only in test mode.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C1246/46
191
Sensor power source 1 (VCM1)
voltage is less than 4.7 V or 5.3 V
or more for at least 0.05 sec.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1246/46
192
Ratio of master pressure sensor
output voltage 1 (PMC1) to
sensor power source (VCM1) is
less than 5% or 90.5% or more
for at least 0.05 sec.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1246/46
194
Sensor power source 2 (VCM2)
voltage is less than 4.7 V or 5.3 V
or more for at least 0.05 sec.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1246/46
195
Ratio of master pressure sensor
output voltage 2 (PMC2) to
sensor power source (VCM2) is
less than 5% or 90.5% or more
for at least 0.05 sec.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1246/46
197
Master pressure sensor output
voltage 1 (PMC1) is abnormal.
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
C1246/46
198
Master pressure sensor output
voltage 2 (PMC2) is abnormal.
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
C1246/46
199
Master pressure sensor output 1
(PMC1) is not approx. 0 Mpa
when not braking.
•
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
Stop input signal
C1246/46
200
Master pressure sensor output 2
(PMC2) is not approx. 0 Mpa
when not braking.
•
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
Stop input signal
C1246/46
201
PMC1 and PMC2 voltages are
different when braking.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1246/46
202
Master pressure sensor 1 data
(PMC1) is invalid.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1246/46
205
Master pressure sensor 2 data
(PMC2) is invalid.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1281/81
-
Detected only during test mode.
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
C1364/61
221
Sensor power source 1 (VCM1)
voltage is less than 4.7 V or 5.3 V
or more for at least 0.05 sec.
•
•
Harness and connector
Skid control ECU
BC
BC–96
BC
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C1364/61
222
Ratio of FR right sensor output
voltage (PFR) to sensor power
source (VCM1) is less than 5% or
90.5% or more for at least 0.05
sec.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1364/61
224
When one of following conditions
is met:
• FR right sensor output (PFR)
is not approx. 0 Mpa when
not braking.
• FR right sensor (PFR) zero
point malfunction.
• Open or short in FR right
sensor (PFR) circuit.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1364/61
225
Ratio of FR right sensor output
voltage (PFR) to sensor power
source (VCM1) is less than
90.5% for at least 0.1 sec. when
self-diagnosis signal is output.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1364/61
226
Voltage difference before and
after changing the pull-up
resistance in the sensor signal
input circuit is 0.3 V or more (poor
connection).
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1364/61
227
Sensor power source 2 (VCM2)
voltage is less than 4.7 V or 5.3 V
or more for at least 0.05 sec.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1364/61
228
Ratio of FR left sensor output
voltage (PFL) to sensor power
source (VCM2) is less than 5% or
90.5% or more for at least 0.05
sec.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1364/61
230
When one of following conditions
is met:
• FR left sensor (PFL) is not
approx. 0 Mpa when not
braking.
• FR left sensor (PFL) zero
point malfunction
• Open or short in FR right
sensor (PFL) circuit.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1364/61
231
Ratio of FR left sensor output
voltage (PFL) to sensor power
source (VCM2) is less than
90.5% for at least 0.1 sec. when
self-diagnosis signal is output.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1364/61
232
Voltage difference before and
after changing the pull-up
resistance in the sensor signal
input circuit is 0.3 V or more (poor
connection).
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1364/61
233
Sensor power source 2 (VCM2)
voltage is less than 4.7 V or 5.3 V
or more for at least 0.05 sec.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1364/61
234
Ratio of RR right sensor output
voltage (PRR) to sensor power
source (VCM2) is less than 5% or
90.5% or more for at least 0.05
sec.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
BC–97
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C1364/61
236
When one of following conditions
is met:
• RR right sensor output
voltage (PRR) is not approx.
0 Mpa when not braking.
• RR right sensor (PRR) zero
point malfunction.
• Open or short in RR sensor
(PRR) circuit.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1364/61
237
Ratio of RR right sensor output
voltage (PRR) to sensor power
source (VCM2) is less than
90.5% for at least 0.1 sec. when
self-diagnosis signal is output.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1364/61
238
Voltage difference before and
after changing the pull-up
resistance in the sensor signal
input circuit is 0.3 V or more (poor
connection).
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1364/61
239
Sensor power source (VCM1)
voltage is less than 4.7 V or 5.3 V
or more for at least 0.05 sec.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1364/61
240
Ratio of RR left sensor output
voltage (PRL) to sensor power
source (VCM1) is less than 5% or
90.5% or more for at least 0.05
sec.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1364/61
242
When one of following conditions
is met:
• RR left sensor output (PRL) is
not approx. 0 Mpa when not
braking.
• RR left sensor (PRL) zero
point malfunction.
• Open or short in RR left
sensor (PRL) circuit.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1364/61
243
Ratio of RR left sensor output
voltage (PRL) to sensor power
source (VCM1) is less than
90.5% for at least 0.1 sec. when
self-diagnosis signal is output.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1364/61
244
Voltage difference before and
after changing the pull-up
resistance in the sensor signal
input circuit is 0.3 V or more (poor
connection).
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
BC
BC–98
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Brake Actuator
Skid Control ECU
PRL
PRL
PFR
PFR
PMC1
PMC1
PACC
PACC
PCK1
PCK1
E1
VCM1
E2
E
VCM1
E2
PRR
PRR
PFL
PFL
PMC2
PMC2
VCM2
VCM2
PCK2
PCK2
C126252E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
BC
NOTICE:
When replacing the skid control ECU, perform initialization of linear solenoid valve and calibration
(see page BC-19).
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
1
BC–99
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SKID CONTROL ECU - BRAKE ACTUATOR)
(a) Disconnect the S7 and S10 ECU connectors.
(b) Disconnect the A2 actuator connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Skid Control ECU
Tester Connection
S7
PFR
PACC
VCM1
VCM2
E
PRL PRR
PFL
PMC1
PCK1
E2
Brake Actuator Assembly
Specified Condition
S7-8 (E) - A2-45 (E1)
Below 1 Ω
S10
S7-9 (VCM1) - A2-35 (VCM1)
Below 1 Ω
PMC2
S7-18 (PRL) - A2-36 (PRL)
Below 1 Ω
S7-21 (PACC) - A2-46 (PACC)
Below 1 Ω
S7-23 (PFR) - A2-34 (PFR)
Below 1 Ω
S7-30 (PMC1) - A2-38 (PMC1)
Below 1 Ω
S7-31 (PCK1) - A2-37 (PCK1)
Below 1 Ω
S10-14 (VCM2) - A2-40 (VCM2)
Below 1 Ω
PCK2
A2
C126274E01
S10-21 (PCK2) - A2-42 (PCK2)
Below 1 Ω
S10-23 (PFL) - A2-39 (PFL)
Below 1 Ω
S10-27 (PMC2) - A2-43 (PMC2)
Below 1 Ω
S10-29 (E2) - A2-44 (E2)
Below 1 Ω
S10-31 (PRR) - A2-41 (PRR)
Below 1 Ω
S7-8 (E) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S7-9 (VCM1) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S7-18 (PRL) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S7-21 (PACC) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S7-23 (PFR) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S7-30 (PCM1) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S7-31 (PCK1) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S10-14 (VCM2) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S10-21 (PCK2) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S10-27 (PMC2) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S10-29 (E2) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S10-31 (PRR) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
BC
BC–100
2
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
CHECK SKID CONTROL ECU
VCM1
E
S7
(a) Measure the voltage of the connectors.
HINT:
Measure the voltage from behind the connector with the
connector connected to the skid control ECU.
Standard voltage
VCM2
E2
S10
F047485E57
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
S7-9 (VCM1) - Body
ground
Power switch ON
(READY)
4.75 to 5.25 V
S10-14 (VCM2) - Body
ground
Power switch ON
(READY)
4.75 to 5.25 V
(b) Measure the resistance of the connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S7-8 (E) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
S10-29 (E2) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
OK
3
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (MASTER CYLINDER PRESSURE SENSOR)
(a) Check the DATA LIST for proper functioning of the
master cylinder pressure sensor.
Skid control ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
MAS CYL PRS 1
Master cylinder pressure sensor
1 reading / Min.: 0 V, Max.: 5 V
When brake pedal is released:
0.3 to 0.9 V
Reading increases when brake
pedal is depressed
MAS CYL PRS 2
Master cylinder pressure sensor
2 reading / Min.: 0 V, Max.: 5 V
When brake pedal is released:
0.3 to 0.9 V
Reading increases when brake
pedal is depressed
OK:
When the pedal is depressed, displayed voltage on
the intelligent tester increase.
NG
BC
REPLACE BRAKE ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
OK
4
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (WHEEL CYLINDER PRESSURE SENSOR)
(a) Connect the pedal effort gauge.
(b) Install the LSPV gauge (SST) and bleed air (see page
BC-205).
SST 09709-29018
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
BC–101
(c) Select the DATA LIST mode on the intelligent tester.
Skid control ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
FR PRESS SENS
Front right pressure sensor / Min.:
0 V, Max.: 5 V
When brake pedal is released:
0.3 to 0.9 V
-
FL PRESS SENS
Front left pressure sensor / Min. 0
V, Max.: 5 V
When brake pedal is released:
0.3 to 0.9 V
-
RR PRESS SENS
Rear right pressure sensor / Min.:
0 V, Max.: 5 V
When brake pedal is released:
0.3 to 0.9 V
-
RL PRESS SENS
Rear left pressure sensor / Min. 0
V, Max.: 5 V
When brake pedal is released:
0.3 to 0.9 V
-
(d) Check the output value the wheel cylinder pressure
sensor at each fluid pressure during the ECB control.
Standard voltage:
Front wheel cylinder pressure sensor
Fluid Pressure
FR PRESS SENS
(DATA-LIST)
FL PRESS SENS
(DATA-LIST)
1 MPa (10.2 kgf/cm2,
145.0 psi)
0.65 to 0.75 V
0.65 to 0.75 V
3 MPa (30.6 kgf/cm2,
435.2 psi)
1.05 to 1.2 V
1.05 to 1.2 V
7 MPa (71.4 kgf/cm2,
1015.5 psi)
1.8 to 2.05 V
1.8 to 2.05 V
10 MPa (102.0 kgf/cm2,
1450.7 psi)
2.4 to 2.7 V
2.4 to 2.7 V
Rear wheel cylinder pressure sensor
Fluid Pressure
RR PRESS SENS
(DATA-LIST)
RL PRESS SENS
(DATA-LIST)
1 MPa (10.2 kgf/cm2,
145.0 psi)
0.65 to 0.75 V
0.65 to 0.75 V
3 MPa (30.6 kgf/cm2,
435.2 psi)
1.05 to 1.2 V
1.05 to 1.2 V
NG
REPLACE BRAKE ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
OK
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
BC
BC–102
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
DTC
C1247/47 Stroke Sensor Malfunction
DTC
C1392/48 Stroke Sensor Zero Point Calibration Undone
DESCRIPTION
The stroke sensor inputs the pedal stroke into the skid control ECU.
BC
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C1247/47
171
Sensor power source voltage
(VCSK) is 3.6 V or less or 4.95 V
or more for at least 1.2 sec.
•
•
•
Brake pedal stroke sensor
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1247/47
172
Ratio of sensor output voltage 1
(SKS1) to sensor power source
voltage (VCSK) is less than 3% or
97% or more for at least 1.2 sec.
•
•
•
Brake pedal stroke sensor
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1247/47
173
Ratio of sensor output voltage 2
(SKS2) to sensor power source
voltage (VCSK) is less than 3% or
97% or more for at least 1.2 sec.
•
•
•
Brake pedal stroke sensor
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1247/47
174
Sensor output 1 (SKS1)
calculation value becomes 20
mm or more for at least 1.2 sec.
at an interval of 0.006 sec.
(changes due to interference).
•
•
•
Brake pedal stroke sensor
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1247/47
175
Sensor output 2 (SKS2)
calculation value becomes 20
mm or more for at least 1.2 sec.
at an interval of 0.006 sec.
(changes due to interference).
•
•
•
Brake pedal stroke sensor
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1247/47
176
Zero point stored value (ratio to
power source voltage) of sensor
output 1 (SKS1) is 0.46 or more
or 0.03 or less.
•
•
•
Brake pedal stroke sensor
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1247/47
177
Zero point stored value (ratio to
power source voltage) of sensor
output 2 (SKS2) is 0.97 or more
or 0.48 or less.
•
•
•
Brake pedal stroke sensor
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1247/47
179
When either condition below is
met:
• Sum of SKS1/VSCK and
SKS2/VSCK is 1.155 or more
or 0.845 or less for at least 1
sec.
• Difference between sensor
output 1 (SKS1) and sensor
output 2 (SKS2) is
excessively large for at least
0.2 sec.
•
•
•
Brake pedal stroke sensor
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1247/47
180
When either condition below is
met:
• Difference between zero
point output value and stored
value is 0.5 or more for at
least 0.05 sec.
• Short between SKS1 and
SKS2 output line.
•
•
•
Brake pedal stroke sensor
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1392/48
178
Zero point calibration of stroke
sensor is unfinished.
•
Brake pedal stroke sensor
zero point calibration undone
(initialization of linear
solenoid valve and calibration
undone)
Skid control ECU
•
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
BC–103
WIRING DIAGRAM
Skid Control ECU
Brake Pedal Stroke Sensor
(Shielded)
SSK
SKS2
SKS2
SKS1
SKS1
SKG
SKG
VCSK
VCSK
C126253E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the skid control ECU, perform initialization of linear solenoid valve and calibration
(see page BC-19).
1
CHECK BRAKE PEDAL
(a) Check that the brake pedal and the brake pedal stroke
sensor are properly installed and that the pedal can be
operated normally.
(b) Check the brake pedal height.
OK:
The brake pedal is securely installed.
The pedal height is within the specified range (see
page BR-22).
NG
ADJUST BRAKE PEDAL
OK
2
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (PEDAL STROKE SENSOR)
(a) Turn the power switch ON (READY).
BC
BC–104
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
(b) Check the DATA LIST for the proper functioning of the
pedal stroke sensor.
Skid control ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal condition
Diagnostic Note
PEDAL STROKE
Stroke sensor / Min.: 0 V, Max.: 5
V
When brake pedal is released:
0.7 to 1.3 V
-
PEDAL STROKE 2
Stroke sensor 2 / Min.: 0 V, Max.:
5V
When brake pedal is released:
3.7 to 4.3 V
-
OK:
The normal condition value displayed on the
intelligent tester.
NG
ADJUST BRAKE PEDAL STROKE SENSOR
OK
3
PERFORM INITIALIZATION OF LINEAR SOLENOID VALVE AND CALIBRATION
NEXT
4
RECONFIRM DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (see page BC-38).
(b) Turn the power switch ON (READY).
(c) Check the same DTCs are recorded (see page BC-38).
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC is output
A
DTC is not output.
B
HINT:
This DTC may be memorized due to a malfunction in the
connector terminal connection, etc.
B
A
BC
END
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
5
BC–105
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SKID CONTROL ECU - BRAKE PEDAL STROKE SENSOR)
(a) Disconnect the S9 ECU connector.
(b) Disconnect the B8 sensor connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Skid Control ECU
Tester Connection
S9
SKG
VCSK
Specified Condition
S9-6 (VCSK) - B8-3 (VCSK)
Below 1 Ω
S9-8 (SKG) - B8-1 (SKG)
Below 1 Ω
S9-21 (SKS1) - B8-4 (SKS1)
Below 1 Ω
SKS
S9-22 (SKS2) - B8-2 (SKS2)
Below 1 Ω
Brake Pedal Stroke Sensor
S9-6 (VCSK) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S9-8 (SKG) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
SKS2
B8
SKS1
SKG
S9-21 (SKS1) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S9-22 (SKS2) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
VCSK
SKS2
F047488E05
OK
6
CHECK SKID CONTROL ECU (VCSK, SKG VOLTAGE)
VCSK
(a) Measure the voltage of the connector.
HINT:
Measure the voltage from behind the connector with the
connector connected to the skid control ECU.
Standard voltage
SKG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S9-6 (VCSK) - S9-8 (SKG)
3.6 to 4.95 V
S9
F047485E58
NG
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
OK
BC
BC–106
7
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
CHECK SKID CONTROL ECU (SKS1, SKS2 VOLTAGE)
S7
GND1
SKS2
(a) Measure the voltage of the connectors.
HINT:
• Measure the voltage from behind the connector with
the connector connected to the skid control ECU.
• Slowly depress the brake pedal and check if the
voltage between the skid control ECU terminals
change in accordance with the pedal operation.
Standard voltage
S9
SKS1
F047485E59
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S9-21 (SKS1) - S7-1 (GND1)
1.8 to 3.1 V
S9-22 (SKS2) - S7-1 (GND1)
1.8 to 3.1 V
NG
OK
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
BC
REPLACE BRAKE PEDAL STROKE
SENSOR
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
DTC
BC–107
C1249/49 Open in Stop Light Switch Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The skid control ECU inputs the stop light switch signal and detects braking condition.
The skid control ECU has a circuit for open detection inside. The skid control ECU outputs the DTC if it
detects an open in the stop light signal input line when the stop light switch is off, or an open in the stop
light circuit (GND side).
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C1249/49
520
Stop light switch circuit is open for
at least 10 sec. when IG1
terminal voltage is between 9.5 V
and 17.02 V
•
•
•
Stop light switch
Stop light switch circuit
Stop light bulb
BC
BC–108
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Skid Control ECU
Stop Light Switch
STP
Rear Combination Light LH
STOP
Rear Combination Light RH
STOP
Noise Filter
(High Mounted Stop Light)
BK/UP LP
High Mounted Stop Light
Rear Combination Light RH
Back-up
Rear Combination Light LH
Back-up
BC
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
C126254E01
BC–109
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
A
B
C
D
E
F
G
H
to Combination Meter
GAUGE
STOP
IG
Power Source
Control ECU
IG1D
AM1
DC/DC
AM1
MAIN
C126255E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the skid control ECU, perform initialization of linear solenoid valve and calibration
(see page BC-19).
BC
BC–110
1
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
CHECK STOP LIGHT SWITCH OPERATION
(a) Check that the stop light comes on when the brake pedal
is depressed and turns off when the brake pedal is
released.
OK
Pedal Condition
Stop Light Condition
Brake pedal depressed
Turns on
Brake pedal released
Turns off
HINT:
Check the stop light bulb as it may have burnt out.
NG
Go to step 4
OK
2
CHECK SKID CONTROL ECU (STP VOLTAGE)
(a) Measure the voltage of the connector.
HINT:
Measure the voltage from behind the connector with the
connector connected to the skid control ECU.
Standard voltage
S8
STP
F047485E60
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
S8-14 (STP) - Body
ground
Brake pedal depressed
8 to 14 V
S8-14 (STP) - Body
ground
Brake pedal released
Below 1 V
NG
Go to step 5
OK
3
RECONFIRM DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (see page BC-38).
(b) Turn the power switch ON (READY).
(c) Check the same DTCs are recorded (see page BC-38).
Result
BC
Result
Proceed to
DTC is not output
A
DTC is output
B
B
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
A
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
4
BC–111
INSPECT STOP LIGHT SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the stop light switch connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the switch.
Standard resistance
Pin
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
Switch pin not pushed
Below 1 Ω
1-2
Switch pin pushed
10 kΩ or higher
NG
Not Pushed
REPLACE STOP LIGHT SWITCH ASSEMBLY
Pushed
2
1
C108891E04
OK
5
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SKID CONTROL ECU - STOP LIGHT SWITCH)
(a) Disconnect the S8 ECU connector.
(b) Disconnect the S16 switch connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Skid Control ECU
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S8-14 (STP) - S16-1
Below 1 Ω
NG
S8
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
STP
Stop Light Switch Assembly
S16
BC
C126276E01
OK
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
BC–112
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
Brake Booster Pump Motor on Time Abnormally Long
DTC
C1252/52
DTC
C1253/53 Hydro Booster Pump Motor Relay Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The skid control ECU detects decreases in the accumulator pressure according to the data from the
accumulator pressure sensor, and then starts and stops the pump motor by operating the motor relay.
The skid control ECU usually drives the motor relay 1 (ABS HTR) for ECB control, and the motor relay 2
(ABS MTR 2) for ABS control. If either is malfunctioning, the other substitutes.
BC
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C1252/52
130
Motor relay is ON for at least 5
min.
Brake actuator assembly
C1253/53
132
Motor relay 1 coil (monitor) is
energized for at least 1 sec. when
main relay 1 monitor (BS1) is 9.5
V or more and motor relay 1 is off.
•
•
•
•
ABS MTR relay
ABS MTR 2 relay
Harness and connector
Brake actuator assembly
C1253/53
133
Motor relay 1 coil (monitor) is not
energized for at least 1 sec. when
main relay 1 monitor (BS1) is 9.5
V or more and motor relay 1 is on.
•
•
•
•
ABS MTR relay
ABS MTR 2 relay
Harness and connector
Brake actuator assembly
C1253/53
134
MTT input is 3.5 V or less for at
least 0.2 sec. when main relay 1
monitor (BS1) is 9.5 V or more
and motor relay 1 is on.
•
•
•
•
ABS MTR relay
ABS MTR 2 relay
Harness and connector
Brake actuator assembly
C1253/53
136
Motor relay 2 coil (monitor) is
energized for at least 1 sec. when
main relay 2 monitor (BS2) is 9.5
V or more and motor relay 2 is off.
•
•
•
•
ABS MTR relay
ABS MTR 2 relay
Harness and connector
Brake actuator assembly
C1253/53
137
Motor relay 2 coil (monitor) is not
energized for at least 1 sec. (0.2
sec. during initial check) when
main relay 2 monitor (BS2) is 9.5
V or more and motor relay 2 is on.
•
•
•
•
ABS MTR relay
ABS MTR 2 relay
Harness and connector
Brake actuator assembly
C1253/53
138
MTT input is 3.5 V or less for at
least 1 sec. (0.2 sec. during initial
check) when main relay 1 monitor
(BS1) is 9.5 V or more and motor
relay 2 is on.
•
•
•
•
ABS MTR relay
ABS MTR 2 relay
Harness and connector
Brake actuator assembly
C1253/53
140
MTT input is 3.5 V or more for at
least 2 sec. when motor relay 1
and 2 are off.
•
•
•
•
ABS MTR relay
ABS MTR 2 relay
Harness and connector
Brake actuator assembly
BC–113
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Brake Actuator
Skid Control ECU
MMT
MTT
MR1+
ABS MTR
BM1
MR1
ABS
MR2+
ABS MTR 2
MR2
BM2
MAIN
ABS-2
ABS-1
GND
GND2
GND1
GND2
GND3
GND4
BC
GND5
GND6
C126256E01
BC–114
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the skid control ECU, perform initialization of linear solenoid valve and calibration
(see page BC-19).
1
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (ABS MOTOR RELAY OPERATION)
(a) Select the ACTIVE TEST, generate a control command,
and then check that the ABS motor relay operates.
Skid control ECU
Item
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
MOTOR RELAY 1
Turns MOTOR RELAY 1 ON / OFF
Operation of solenoid (clicking sound) can be
heard
MOTOR RELAY 2
Turns MOTOR RELAY 2 ON / OFF
Operation of solenoid (clicking sound) can be
heard
OK:
The operation sound of the ABS motor should be
heard.
NG
Go to step 6
OK
2
INSPECT FUSE (ABS-1, ABS-2)
(a) Remove the ABS-1 and ABS-2 fuses from the engine
room relay block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the fuses.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
Engine Room Relay Block
NG
ABS-1
Fuse
ABS-2
Fuse
BC
F047765E01
OK
CHECK FOR SHORTS IN ALL HARNESS
AND CONNECTOR CONNECTED TO FUSE
AND REPLACE FUSE
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
3
BC–115
INSPECT BRAKE ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
BM1
MTT
GND2
BM2
GND1
F047491E03
(a) Disconnect the brake actuator connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the actuator.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1 (BM2) - 31 (GND1)
Below 10 Ω
2 (BM1) - 31 (GND1)
Below 10 Ω
1 (BM2) - 2 (BM1)
Below 1 Ω
31 (GND1) - 32 (GND2)
Below 1 Ω
1 (BM2) - 33 (MTT)
About 33 Ω
2 (BM1) - 33 (MTT)
About 33 Ω
NG
REPLACE BRAKE ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
OK
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SKID CONTROL ECU - BRAKE ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY)
(a) Disconnect the S7 ECU connector.
(b) Disconnect the A2 actuator connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Skid Control ECU
Specified Condition
S7-29 (MTT) - A2-33 (MTT)
Below 1 Ω
A2-31 (GND1) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
A2-32 (GND2) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
S7
MTT
A2
Tester Connection
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
Brake Actuator Assembly
BC
GND1
MTT
GND2
F047492E10
OK
BC–116
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
5
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (ACCUMULATOR PRESSURE SENSOR)
(a) Check the DATA LIST for proper functioning of the
accumulator pressure sensor.
(b) Depress the brake pedal 4 or 5 times to operate the
pump motor, and check the output value on the
intelligent tester with the motor stopped (not braking).
Skid control ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
ACC PRESS SENS 1
Accumulator pressure sensor 1 /
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 5 V
Specified value: 3.2 to 4.0 V
-
OK:
Accumulator pressure sensor voltage does not
drop.
NG
REPLACE BRAKE ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
OK
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
6
INSPECT RELAY (Marking: ABS MTR, ABS MTR 2)
(a) Remove the ABS MTR and ABS MTR 2 relays from the
engine room relay block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the relays.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to
terminals 1 and 2)
B112776E02
NG
OK
BC
REPLACE RELAY
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
7
BC–117
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ENGINE ROOM RELAY BLOCK - BATTERY)
(a) Remove the ABS MTR and MTR 2 relays from the
engine room relay block.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
Engine Room Relay Block
ABS MTR Relay (5)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
ABS MTR relay terminal 5 - Body
ground
10 to 14 V
ABS MTR 2 relay terminal 5 - Body
ground
10 to 14 V
NG
ABS MTR 2 Relay (5)
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
F047688E01
OK
BC
BC–118
8
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ENGINE ROOM RELAY BLOCK - BRAKE ACTUATOR)
(a) Disconnect the A2 actuator connector.
(b) Remove the ABS MTR and ABS MTR 2 relays from the
engine room relay block.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Brake Actuator Assembly
A2
BM2
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A2-1 (BM2) - ABS MTR 2 relay
terminal 3
Below 1 Ω
A2-2 (BM1) - ABS MTR relay terminal
3
Below 1 Ω
BM1
A2-1 (BM2) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
Engine Room Relay Block
A2-2 (BM1) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
ABS MTR
Relay (3)
NG
ABS MTR 2 Relay (3)
F047493E01
OK
BC
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
9
BC–119
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ENGINE ROOM RELAY BLOCK - SKID CONTROL ECU)
(a) Disconnect the S7 and S10 ECU connectors.
(b) Remove the ABS MTR and MTR 2 relays from the
engine room relay block.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Skid Control ECU
S7
S10
MR2+
MR1+ MR2
MR1
Engine Room Relay Block
ABS MTR
Relay (1)
ABS MTR
Relay (2)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S7-11 (MR1+) - ABS MTR relay
terminal 2
Below 1 Ω
S7-25 (MR1) - ABS MTR relay
terminal 1
Below 1 Ω
S10-25 (MR2+) - ABS MTR 2 relay
terminal 2
Below 1 Ω
S10-30 (MR2) - ABS MTR 2 relay
terminal 1
Below 1 Ω
S7-11 (MR1+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S7-25 (MR1) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S10-25 (MR2+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S10-30 (MR2) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
ABS MTR 2 Relay (2)
ABS MTR 2 Relay (1)
F047494E01
OK
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
BC
BC–120
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
DTC
C1256/57 Accumulator Low Pressure
DESCRIPTION
The accumulator pressure sensor is built into the actuator and detects the accumulator pressure.
The skid control ECU turns on the Brake Control warning light and sounds the skid control buzzer if it
senses a decrease in the accumulator pressure.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C1256/57
141
When either condition below is
met:
• Braking operation is input
when accumulator pressure
is less than 12.45 MPa and
vehicle speed is input
(detected value changes if
accumulator pressure is low
after system start).
• Accumulator pressure is less
than 14.62 MPa for 120 sec.
(changes according to power
source voltage) after system
start (stores the DTC after the
conditions are met, and
drives buzzer).
Brake actuator assembly
(accumulator pressure,
accumulator pressure sensor,
pump motor)
C1256/57
143
When one of following conditions
is met:
• Any of the wheel cylinder
pressure sensor value is
lower than the target value for
at least 0.5 sec. when
accumulator pressure is less
than 14.62 MPa and vehicle
speed is input.
• Accumulator pressure
changes little when
accumulator pressure is less
than 14.62 MPa for at least 1
sec. without braking (pump
motor is operating).
• Accumulator pressure is less
than 14.62 MPa for at least
0.5 sec. when motor relay is
malfunctioning.
Brake actuator assembly
(accumulator pressure,
accumulator pressure sensor,
pump motor)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
BC
NOTICE:
When replacing the skid control ECU, perform initialization of linear solenoid valve and calibration
(see page BC-19).
HINT:
DTCs may be output if the accumulator pressure drops due to frequent braking (this is not a malfunction).
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
1
BC–121
INSPECT BRAKE ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
BM1
MTT
BM2
GND2
GND1
F047491E03
(a) Disconnect the brake actuator connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the actuator.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1 (BM2) - 31 (GND1)
Below 10 Ω
2 (BM1) - 31 (GND1)
Below 10 Ω
1 (BM2) - 2 (BM1)
Below 1 Ω
31 (GND1) - 32 (GND2)
Below 1 Ω
1 (BM2) - 33 (MTT)
Approx. 10 Ω
2 (BM1) - 33 (MTT)
Approx. 10 Ω
NG
REPLACE BRAKE ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
OK
2
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (ACCUMULATOR PRESSURE SENSOR)
(a) Check the DATA LIST for proper functioning of the
accumulator pressure sensor.
(b) Depress the brake pedal 4 or 5 times to operate the
pump motor, and check the output value on the
intelligent tester with the motor stopped (not braking).
Skid control ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal condition
Diagnostic Note
ACC PRESS SENS 1
Accumulator pressure sensor 1 /
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 5 V
Specified value: 3.2 to 4.0 V
-
OK:
Accumulator pressure sensor's output voltage
does not drop.
NG
REPLACE BRAKE ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
OK
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
BC
BC–122
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
DTC
C1259/58 HV System Regenerative Malfunction
DTC
C1310/51 Malfunction in HV system
DESCRIPTION
The skid control ECU communicates with the hybrid control ECU and controls braking force according to
the motor's regenerative force.
The skid control ECU sends Enhanced VSC signal to the hybrid control ECU and inputs operating signal
from the hybrid control ECU.
The skid control ECU uses CAN communication for communication with the hybrid control ECU. If a
communication malfunction is memorized, the skid control ECU prohibits Enhanced VSC operation and a
part of ECB control by fail-safe function.
C1259/59 is stored if the power switch is ON (READY) with the HV battery service plug disconnected.
BC
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C1259/58
150
The regeneration malfunction
signal is input for at least 0.02
sec. when IG2 terminal voltage is
9.5 V or more for at least 2 sec.
and communication with hybrid
control ECU is valid.
Hybrid control system
C1310/51
156
The traction control prohibition
signal is received for at least 0.07
sec. when IG2 terminal voltage is
10.5 V or more for at least 1.5
sec. and communication with
hybrid control ECU is valid.
Hybrid control system
(Enhanced VSC)
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
BC–123
WIRING DIAGRAM
Skid Control ECU
Gateway ECU
CA1L
CA1H
Hybrid Control ECU
CANL
CAN-L
CANH
CAN-H
C126257E01
HINT:
This DTC is output from the skid control ECU when the hybrid control ECU sends a malfunction signal to
the skid control ECU.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
(a) Check the hybrid control system (see page HV-55).
NEXT
END
BC
BC–124
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
DTC
C1300
Skid Control ECU Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The skid control ECU outputs this DTC if malfunctions are found in the circuit inside the computer by selfdiagnosis.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detecting Condition
Trouble Area
C1300/-
-
Malfunction in skid control ECU
Skid control ECU
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the skid control ECU, perform initialization of linear solenoid valve and calibration
(see page BC-19).
1
CHECK DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (see page BC-38).
(b) Turn the power switch ON (READY).
(c) Check the same DTCs are recorded (see page BC-38).
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC is output
A
DTC is not output
B
B
A
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
BC
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEMS TABLE
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
DTC
C1311/11 Open in Main Relay 1 Circuit
DTC
C1312/12 Short in Main Relay 1 Circuit
DTC
C1313/13 Open in Main Relay 2 Circuit
DTC
C1314/14 Short in Main Relay 2 Circuit
BC–125
DESCRIPTION
ABS main relay 1 (ABS NO. 1 relay) supplies power to the changeover solenoid and the linear solenoid.
ABS main relay 2 (ABS NO. 2 relay) goes on for approximately 5 seconds after the power switch is turned
off and the braking effort signal input is terminated. ABS main relay 2 (ABS NO. 2 relay) supplies
electricity and maintains operating condition for the brake system when the power switch is OFF.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C1311/11
1
When either condition below is
met:
• Relay contact is off (BS 1
terminal is less than 3.5 V) for
at least 0.2 sec. when R1+
terminal voltage is 9.5 V or
more and main relay 1 is on.
• R1+ terminal voltage is less
than 9.5 V and main relay 1
cannot be on for at least 0.2
sec. when main relay 1 is
turned on (BS 1 terminal is
3.5 V or more).
•
Relay contact is on for at least 4
sec. when main relay 1 is off.
•
C1312/12
3
•
•
•
•
C1313/13
C1314/14
4
6
When either condition below is
met:
• Relay contact is off (BS2
terminal is less than 3.5 V) for
at least 0.2 sec. when R2+
terminal voltage is 9.5 V or
more and main relay 2 is on.
• R2+ terminal voltage is less
than 9.5 V and main relay 2
cannot be on for at least 2
sec. when main relay 2 is
turned on (BS 1 terminal is
3.5 V or more).
•
Relay contact is on for at least 4
sec. when main relay 2 is off.
•
•
•
•
•
ABS main relay 1
(ABS NO. 1 relay)
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
ABS main relay 1
(ABS NO. 1 relay)
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
ABS main relay 2
(ABS NO. 2 relay)
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
ABS main relay 2
(ABS NO. 2 relay)
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
BC
BC–126
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Brake Actuator
Skid Control ECU
SMC1
SMC1
SMC2
SMC2
BS2
R2+
ABS NO. 2
SR2
ABS NO. 1
SR1
R1+
BS1
+BI1
+BI2
BC
IG
OUT2
+BO2
OUT1
+BO1
GND
BC
IG1
Brake Control Power Supply
A
B C D E
F
C126258E01
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
BC–127
F
A B C D E
ECU-IG
IG1
AM1
IG2
AM2
IG2D
P/I
AM2
AM1
IG1D
Power Source
Control ECU
DC/DC
ABS MAIN3
BC
ABS MAIN2
ABS MAIN1
A
B C
D
E
C126250E01
BC–128
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
E
A B C D
IGN
IG2
GND1
GND2
GND3
GND4
GND5
MAIN
GND6
GND1
GND2
C126259E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the skid control ECU, perform initialization of linear solenoid valve and calibration
(see page BC-19).
1
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (ABS NO. 1 RELAY, ABS NO. 2
RELAY)
(a) Select the ACTIVE TEST for the proper functioning of
the ABS NO. 1 and ABS NO. 2 relays.
Skid control ECU
BC
Item
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
MAIN RELAY 2
Turns MAIN RELAY 1 ON / OFF
Operation of solenoid (clicking sound) can be
heard
MAIN RELAY 1
Turns MAIN RELAY 2 ON / OFF
Operation of solenoid (clicking sound) can be
heard
OK:
Operation sound of ABS NO. 1 relay and ABS NO. 2
relay should be heard.
NG
OK
Go to step 3
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
2
S7
BC–129
CHECK SKID CONTROL ECU (BS1, BS2 VOLTAGE)
BS2
BS1
S10
(a) Measure the voltage of the connectors.
HINT:
Measure the voltage from behind the connector with the
connector connected to the skid control ECU.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S7-3 (BS1) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
S10-7 (BS2) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
F047485E61
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
3
INSPECT FUSE (ABS MAIN1, ABS MAIN2)
(a) Remove the ABS MAIN1 and ABS MAIN2 fuses from the
engine room relay block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the fuses.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
Engine Room Relay Block
NG
CHECK FOR SHORT IN ALL HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR CONNECTED TO FUSE AND
REPLACE FUSE
ABS MAIN2 Fuse
ABS MAIN1 Fuse
F047495E01
OK
BC
BC–130
4
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
INSPECT ABS MAIN RELAY (Marking: ABS NO. 1, ABS NO. 2)
1
5
(a) Remove the ABS NO. 1 and ABS NO. 2 relays from the
engine room relay block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the relays.
Standard resistance
2
3
5
1
2
3
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to
terminals 1 and 2
B060778E30
NG
REPLACE RELAY
OK
5
CHECK SKID CONTROL ECU (+BI1, +BI2 VOLTAGE)
(a) Measure the voltage of the connectors.
HINT:
Measure the voltage from behind the connector with the
connector connected to the skid control ECU.
Standard voltage
+BI1 +BI2
S8
S9
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S8-3 (+BI1) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
S9-5 (+BI2) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
F047485E62
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
6
CHECK SKID CONTROL ECU (+BO1, +BO2, R1+, R2+ VOLTAGE)
S7
S8
S9
(a) Measure the voltage of the connectors.
HINT:
Measure the voltage from behind the connector with the
connector connected to the skid control ECU.
Standard voltage
S10
BC
R1+
+BO1
+BO2
R2+
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S7-2 (R1+) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
S8-5 (+BO1) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
S9-4 (+BO2) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
S10-17 (R2+) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
F047485E63
NG
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
7
BC–131
CHECK SKID CONTROL ECU (BS1, BS2 VOLTAGE)
BS1
(a) Measure the voltage of the connectors.
HINT:
Measure the voltage from behind the connector with the
connector connected to the skid control ECU.
Standard voltage
BS2
Tester Connection
S7
S10
Specified Condition
S7-3 (BS1) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
S10-7 (BS2) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
F047485E64
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
BC
BC–132
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
DTC
C1315/31 SMC1 Changeover Solenoid Malfunction
DTC
C1316/32 SMC2 Changeover Solenoid Malfunction
DTC
C1352/21
Front Increasing Pressure Solenoid RH Malfunction
DTC
C1353/23
Front Increasing Pressure Solenoid LH Malfunction
DTC
C1354/25
Rear Increasing Pressure Solenoid RH Malfunction
DTC
C1355/27
Rear Increasing Pressure Solenoid LH Malfunction
DTC
C1356/22
Front Decreasing Pressure Solenoid RH Malfunction
DTC
C1357/24
Front Decreasing Pressure Solenoid LH Malfunction
DTC
C1358/26
Rear Decreasing Pressure Solenoid RH Malfunction
DTC
C1359/28
Rear Decreasing Pressure Solenoid LH Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
BC
Each solenoid adjusts pressure which affects each wheel cylinder according to signals from the skid
control ECU and controls the vehicle.
The master cut solenoid (SMC 1/2) is closed and blocks the master cylinder pressure from the ECB
control pressure when the system is normal. The master cut solenoid is open and sends the master
cylinder fluid pressure to the non-assisted brake wheel cylinders during the fail-safe due to system
malfunction.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C1315/31
61
When either condition below is
met:
• SMC1 drive circuit is
malfunctioning for 0.05 sec.
or more.
• Short to +B.
•
Open circuit in SMC1 continues
for 0.05 sec. or more when SMC1
is off
•
C1315/31
62
•
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
(SMC1)
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
Brake actuator assembly
(SMC1)
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C1315/31
63
Open circuit in SMC1 continues
for 0.05 sec. or more when SMC1
is off.
•
Over current in SMC1 continues
for 0.05 sec. or more.
•
C1315/31
64
•
•
•
•
C1316/32
C1316/32
C1316/32
66
67
68
When either condition below is
met:
• SMC1 driver circuit is
malfunctioning for 0.05 sec.
or more.
• Short to +B
•
Open circuit in SMC2 continues
for 0.05 sec. or more when SMC2
is off.
•
Open circuit in SMC2 continues
for 0.05 sec. or more.
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
C1316/32
69
Over current in SMC2 continues
for 0.05 sec. or more.
•
BC–133
Brake actuator assembly
(SMC1)
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
Brake actuator assembly
(SMC1)
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
Brake actuator assembly
(SMC2)
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
Brake actuator assembly
(SMC2)
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
Brake actuator assembly
(SMC2)
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
(SMC2)
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1352/21
11
Open circuit in SLAFR continues
for 0.05 sec. or more when
SLAFR is off.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1352/21
12
Open circuit in SLAFR continues
for 0.05 sec. or more when
SLAFR is on.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1352/21
13
Short to +B or voltage leak in
SLAFR continues for 0.05 sec. or
more.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1352/21
14
Over current in SLAFR continues
for 0.05 sec. or more.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1353/23
21
Open circuit in SLAFL continues
for 0.05 sec. or more when
SLAFL is off.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1353/23
22
Open circuit in SLAFL continues
for 0.05 sec. or more when
SLAFL is on.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1353/23
23
Short to +B or voltage leak in
SLAFL continues for 0.05 sec. or
more.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1353/23
24
Over current in SLAFL continues
for 0.05 sec. or more.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1354/25
31
Open circuit in SLARR continues
for 0.05 sec. or more when
SLARR is off.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1354/25
32
Open circuit in SLARR continues
for 0.05 sec. or more when
SLARR is on.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1354/25
33
Short to +B or voltage leak in
SLARR continues for 0.05 sec. or
more.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1354/25
34
Over current in SLARR continues
for 0.05 sec. or more.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
BC
BC–134
BC
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C1355/27
41
Open circuit in SLARL continues
for 0.05 sec. or more when
SLARL is off.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1355/27
42
Open circuit in SLARL continues
for 0.05 sec. or more when
SLARL is on.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1355/27
43
Short to +B or voltage leak in
SLARL continues for 0.05 sec. or
more.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1355/27
44
Over current in SLARL continues
for 0.05 sec. or more.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1356/22
16
Open circuit in SLRFR continues
for 0.05 sec. or more when
SLRFR is off.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1356/22
17
Open circuit in SLRFR continues
for 0.05 sec. or more when
SKRFR is on.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1356/22
18
Short to +B or voltage leak in
SLRFR continues for 0.05 sec. or
more.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1356/22
19
Over current in SLRFR continues
for 0.05 sec. or more.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1357/24
26
Open circuit in SLRFL continues
or 0.05 sec. or more when SLRFL
is off.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1357/24
27
Open circuit in SLRFL continues
for 0.05 sec. or more when
SLRFL is on.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1357/24
28
Short to +B or voltage leak in
SLRFL continues for 0.05 sec. or
more.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1357/24
29
Over current in SLRFL continues
for 0.05 sec. or more.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1358/26
36
Open circuit in SLRRR continues
for 0.05 sec. or more when
SLRRR is off.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1358/26
37
Open circuit in SLRRR continues
for 0.05 sec. or more when
SLRRR is on.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1358/26
38
Short to +B or voltage leak in
SLRRR continues for 0.05 sec. or
more.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1358/26
39
Over current in SLRRR continues
for 0.05 sec. or more.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1359/28
46
Open circuit in SLRRL continues
for 0.05 sec. or more when
SLRRL is off.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1359/28
47
Open circuit in SLRRL continues
for 0.05 sec. or more when
SLRRL is on.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1359/28
48
Short to +B or voltage leak in
SLRRL continues for 0.05 sec. or
more.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1359/28
49
Over current in SLRRL continues
for 0.05 sec. or more.
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
BC–135
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Brake Actuator Assembly
FRFR+
RLRL+
RLRL+
RRRR+
RRRR+
FLFL+
FLFL+
FRFR+
SMC2
SMC1
Skid Control ECU
SLAFRSLAFR+
SLRRLSLRRL+
SLARLSLARL+
SLRRRSLRRR+
SLARRSLARR+
SLRFLSLRFL+
SLAFLSLAFL+
SLRFR-
BC
SLRFR+
SMC2
SMC1
C126260E01
BC–136
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
R2+
ABS NO. 2
BS2
SR2
BS1
ABS NO. 1
Brake Master Stroke Simulator
Cylinder Assembly
SR1
BSR
R1+
BCSS
SCSS
Brake Control Power Supply
BC
OUT2
+BO2
OUT
+BO1
IG
ECU-IG
IG1
Power Source Control ECU
IG1D
AM1
AM1
BC
DC/DC
ABS MAIN
MAIN
C126261E01
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
BC–137
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the skid control ECU, perform initialization of linear solenoid valve and calibration
(see page BC-19).
1
INSPECT BRAKE ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
RR+ RL+ FR+
RR- RL- BS2 SMC2
RL+
FL-
(a) Disconnect the brake actuator connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the actuator.
HINT:
Check the brake actuator when it is cooled down.
Standard resistance
FR-
Tester Connection
FL-
FL+
FR+
FR-
Specified Condition
20 (SMC1) - 7 (BS2)
14.6 to 24.6 Ω
6 (SMC2) - 19 (BS1)
14.6 to 24.6 Ω
8 (FR+) - 5 (FR-)
3.5 to 4.3 Ω
22 (FR+) - 21 (FR-)
3.5 to 4.3 Ω
F047491E04
13 (FL+) - 14 (FL-)
3.5 to 4.3 Ω
27 (FL+) - 28 (FL-)
3.5 to 4.3 Ω
12 (RR+) - 11 (RR-)
3.5 to 4.3 Ω
10 (RL+) - 9 (RL-)
3.5 to 4.3 Ω
NG
REPLACE BRAKE ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
OK
2
CHECK SKID CONTROL ECU (VALVE VOLTAGE)
SMC2
SLAFLS10
SLAFL+
SMC1
SLAFR-
S9
S8
S7
SLAFR+
SLARRSLRFL+
SLRRR-
SLRFR+
SLARL-
SLRFR-
BC
SLRRL+
SLFRL-
SLRFLSLRRR+ SLARR+
SLARL+
C126241E01
(a) Measure the voltage of the ECU connector.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
S7-4 (SMC1) - Body
ground
Power switch ON
(READY)
Brake pedal released
Below 10 to 14 V
BC–138
BC
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
S10-3 (SMC2) - Body
ground
Power switch ON
(READY)
Brake pedal released
Below 10 to 14 V
S7-7 (SLAFR+) - Body
ground
Power switch ON
(READY)
Brake pedal released
Pulse generation*
S7-6 (SLAFR-) - Body
ground
Power switch ON
(READY)
Brake pedal released
Pulse generation*
S10-1 (SLAFL+) - Body
ground
Power switch ON
(READY)
Brake pedal released
Pulse generation*
S10-2 (SLAFL-) - Body
ground
Power switch ON
(READY)
Brake pedal released
Pulse generation*
S10-19 (SLARR+) Body ground
Power switch ON
(READY)
Brake pedal released
Pulse generation*
S10-9 (SLARR-) - Body
ground
Power switch ON
(READY)
Brake pedal released
Pulse generation*
S7-15 (SLARL+) - Body
ground
Power switch ON
(READY)
Brake pedal released
Pulse generation*
S7-27 (SLARL-) - Body
ground
Power switch ON
(READY)
Brake pedal released
Pulse generation*
S7-17 (SLRFR+) - Body
ground
Power switch ON
(READY)
Brake pedal released
Below 1.5 V
S10-8 (SLRFL+) - Body
ground
Power switch ON
(READY)
Brake pedal released
Below 1.5 V
S10-20 (SLRRR+) Body ground
Power switch ON
(READY)
Brake pedal released
Below 1.5 V
S7-16 (SLRRL+) - Body
ground
Power switch ON
(READY)
Brake pedal released
Below 1.5 V
S7-34 (SLRFR-) - Body
ground
Power switch ON
(READY)
Below 1.5 V
S10-26 (SLRFL-) - Body
ground
Power switch ON
(READY)
Brake pedal released
Below 1.5 V
S10-18 (SLRRR-) - Body
ground
Power switch ON
(READY)
Brake pedal released
Below 1.5 V
S7-26 (SLRRL-) - Body
ground
Power switch ON
(READY)
Brake pedal released
Below 1.5 V
HINT:
*: Refer to waveform 5 of "TERMINALS OF ECU" (see
page BC-29).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
BC–139
OK
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
BC
BC–140
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
DTC
C1319/35 SCSS Changeover Solenoid Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The stroke simulator solenoid (SCSS) generates pedal reactive effort during ECB control. If one of the 4
wheels loses brake booster function, the stroke simulator operation is prohibited.
BC
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C1319/35
71
When either condition below is
met:
• SCSS drive circuit is
malfunctioning for 0.05 sec.
or more.
• Short to +B in SCSS
•
•
•
Stroke simulator
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1319/35
72
Current leaks for 0.05 sec. or
more when SCSS is off.
•
•
•
Stroke simulator
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1319/35
73
Open circuit in SCSS continues
for 0.05 sec. or more.
•
•
•
Stroke simulator
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
C1319/35
74
Over current in SCSS continues
for 0.05 sec. or more.
•
•
•
Stroke simulator
Skid control ECU
Harness and connector
BC–141
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Brake Master Stroke Simulator
Cylinder Assembly
Brake Actuator
Skid Control ECU
SCSS
BCSS
BS1
BS1
BSR
Brake Control Power Supply
ABS NO. 1
OUT
R1+
SR1
ECU-IG
IG
Power Source Control ECU
IG1
IG1D
AM1
AM1
DC/DC
BC
ABS MAIN
MAIN
BC
C126262E01
BC–142
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the skid control ECU, perform initialization of linear solenoid valve and calibration
(see page BC-19).
1
INSPECT BRAKE MASTER STROKE SIMULATOR CYLINDER ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect brake master stroke simulator cylinder
connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the cylinder.
Standard resistance
BCSS
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1 (BSR) - 2 (BCSS)
22.3 to 38 Ω
BSR
NG
F047498E06
REPLACE BRAKE MASTER STROKE
SIMULATOR CYLINDER ASSEMBLY
OK
2
CHECK BRAKE MASTER STROKE SIMULATOR CYLINDER ASSEMBLY (BSR VOLTAGE)
(a) Connect the brake master stroke simulator cylinder
connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the connector.
HINT:
Measure the voltage from the behind the connector with
the connector connected.
Standard voltage
B18
BSR
F047498E07
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
B17-1 (BSR) - Body
ground
Power switch ON
(READY)
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
3
BC
CHECK SKID CONTROL ECU (SCSS VOLTAGE)
(a) Select the ACTIVE TEST mode on the intelligent tester.
Skid control ECU
Item
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
SCC PATTERN
Stroke simulator cut valve pattern activation
ON / OFF
Operation of solenoid (clicking sound) can be
heard
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
BC–143
(b) Use the ACTIVE TEST commands shown below to turn
the stroke simulator cylinder ON or OFF, and measure
the voltage of the SCSS terminal.
Standard voltage
SCSS
S7
F047485E65
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
S7-13 (SCSS) - Body
ground
Brake master stroke
simulator cylinder
ON
Below 1.5 V
S7-13 (SCSS) - Body
ground
Brake master stroke
simulator cylinder
OFF
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
BC
BC–144
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
DTC
C1341/62 Front Hydraulic System RH Malfunction
DTC
C1342/63 Front Hydraulic System LH Malfunction
DTC
C1343/64 Rear Hydraulic System RH Malfunction
DTC
C1344/65 Rear Hydraulic System LH Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The skid control ECU controls braking force according to the hybrid system regenerative braking force
and inputs the fluid pressure necessary for operating each wheel cylinder according to the wheel cylinder
pressure sensor.
DTCs may be stored if brake fluid leaks, wheel cylinder vibrates due to uneven wear of the brake disc
rotor, or foreign matter enters the solenoid valve.
DTCs may be stored if the line pressure drops during air bleeding.
BC
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C1341/62
551
Hydraulic pressure control on FR
wheel has deteriorated.
•
•
Fluid leakage
Brake actuator assembly
C1341/62
552
Hydraulic pressure control on FR
wheel has deteriorated.
•
•
Fluid leakage
Brake actuator assembly
C1341/62
553
There is a malfunction, such as
leakage in the pressure increase
control valve of FR wheel.
•
•
•
Fluid leakage
Brake actuator assembly
Disc rotor
C1341/62
554
There is a malfunction, such as
leakage in the pressure decrease
control valve of FR wheel.
•
•
•
Fluid leakage
Brake actuator assembly
Disc rotor
C1341/62
555
There is a malfunction, such as
leakage in the pressure decrease
control valve of FR wheel.
•
•
•
Fluid leakage
Brake actuator assembly
Disc rotor
C1342/63
561
Hydraulic pressure control on FL
wheel has deteriorated.
•
•
Fluid leakage
Brake actuator
C1342/63
562
Hydraulic pressure control on FL
wheel has deteriorated.
•
•
Fluid leakage
Brake actuator
C1342/63
563
There is a malfunction, such as
leakage in pressure increase
control valve of FL wheel.
•
•
•
Fluid leakage
Brake actuator assembly
Disc rotor
C1342/63
564
There is a malfunction, such as
leakage in pressure decrease
control valve of FL wheel.
•
•
•
Fluid leakage
Brake actuator assembly
Disc rotor
C1342/63
565
There is a malfunction, such as
leakage in pressure decrease
control valve of FL wheel.
•
•
•
Fluid leakage
Brake actuator assembly
Disc rotor
C1343/64
571
Hydraulic pressure control on RR
wheel has deteriorated.
•
•
Fluid leakage
Brake actuator
C1343/64
572
Hydraulic pressure control on RR
wheel has deteriorated.
•
•
Fluid leakage
Brake actuator
C1343/64
573
There is a malfunction, such as
leakage in pressure increase
control valve of RR wheel.
•
•
•
Fluid leakage
Brake actuator assembly
Disc rotor
C1343/64
574
There is a malfunction, such as
leakage in pressure decrease
control valve of RR wheel.
•
•
•
Fluid leakage
Brake actuator assembly
Disc rotor
C1343/64
575
There is a malfunction, such as
leakage in pressure decrease
control valve of RR wheel.
•
•
•
Fluid leakage
Brake actuator assembly
Disc rotor
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
BC–145
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C1344/65
581
Hydraulic pressure control on RL
wheel has deteriorated.
•
•
Fluid leakage
Brake actuator
C1344/65
582
Hydraulic pressure control on RL
wheel has deteriorated.
•
•
Fluid leakage
Brake actuator
C1344/65
583
There is a malfunction, such as
leakage in pressure increase
control valve of RR wheel.
•
•
•
Fluid leakage
Brake actuator assembly
Disc rotor
C1344/65
584
There is a malfunction, such as
leakage in pressure decrease
control valve of RR wheel.
•
•
•
Fluid leakage
Brake actuator assembly
Disc rotor
C1344/65
585
There is a malfunction, such as
leakage in pressure decrease
control valve of RL wheel.
•
•
•
Fluid leakage
Brake actuator assembly
Disc rotor
BC
BC–146
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Brake Actuator Assembly
FRFR+
RLRL+
RLRL+
RRRR+
RRRR+
FLFL+
FLFL+
FRFR+
BC
SMC2
SMC1
Skid Control ECU
SLAFRSLAFR+
SLRRLSLRRL+
SLARLSLARL+
SLRRRSLRRR+
SLARRSLARR+
SLRFLSLRFL+
SLAFLSLAFL+
SLRFRSLRFR+
SMC2
SMC1
C126260E01
BC–147
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
R2+
ABS NO. 2
BS2
SR2
BS1
ABS NO. 1
Brake Master Stroke Simulator
Cylinder Assembly
SR1
BSR
R1+
BCSS
SCSS
Brake Control Power Supply
BC
OUT2
+BO2
OUT
+BO1
IG
ECU-IG
IG1
Power Source Control ECU
IG1D
AM1
AM1
BC
DC/DC
ABS MAIN
MAIN
C126261E01
BC–148
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the skid control ECU, perform initialization of linear solenoid valve and calibration
(see page BC-19).
HINT:
When C1364/61 is output together with C1341/62, C1342/63, C1343/64 and C1344/65, inspect and repair
the trouble areas indicated by C1364/61 first.
1
CHECK BRAKE FLUID LEAKAGE
(a) Check that there is no fluid leakage in the brake line
between the brake actuator and the wheel cylinder which
is the cause of DTCs.
(b) Check that the brake is not dragging.
OK:
There is no fluid leakage or dragging.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE APPLICABLE PART
OK
2
PERFORM AIR BLEED
(a) Bleed the air out of the front and rear systems (see page
BR-3).
NEXT
3
RECONFIRM DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (see page BC-38).
(b) Turn the power switch ON (READY).
(c) Check the same DTCs are recorded (see page BC-38).
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC is output
A
DTC is not output
B
HINT:
DTC may be stored if foreign matter or air enters the
solenoid valve.
BC
B
A
END
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
4
BC–149
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SKID CONTROL ECU - BRAKE ACTUATOR)
(a) Disconnect the S7 and S10 connectors.
(b) Disconnect the A2 actuator connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Skid Control ECU
SLAFL+
SLAFR+ SLAFR- SLAFLSLRFR+
SLRRL+
SLARRS7
SLRRR+
SLRFL+
S10
SLALR-
SLARL+
SLARR+ SLRRRSLRFR- SLRRLSLRFL-
Brake Actuator Assembly
A2
FR-
RLFR+
RR+ RR+ FL+
RL+
FL-
FR- FR+
RR- FL+
RL+
FLRLRR+
C132866E01
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S7-6 (SLAFR-) - A2-5 (FR-)
Below 1 Ω
S7-7 (SLAFR+) - A2-8 (FR+)
Below 1 Ω
S7-15 (SLARL+) - A2-10 (RL+)
Below 1 Ω
S7-16 (SLRRL+) - A2-24 (RL+)
Below 1 Ω
S7-17 (SLRFR+) - A2-22 (FR+)
Below 1 Ω
S7-26 (SLRRL-) - A2-23 (RL-)
Below 1 Ω
S7-27 (SLARL-) - A2-9 (RL-)
Below 1 Ω
S7-34 (SLRFR-) - A2-21 (FR-)
Below 1 Ω
S10-1 (SLAFL+) - A2-13 (FL+)
Below 1 Ω
S10-2 (SLAFL-) - A2-14 (FL-)
Below 1 Ω
S10-8 (SLRFL+) - A2-27 (FL+)
Below 1 Ω
S10-9 (SLARR-) - A2-11 (RR-)
Below 1 Ω
S10-18 (SLRRR-) - A2-25 (RR-)
Below 1 Ω
S10-19 (SLARR+) - A2-12 (RR+)
Below 1 Ω
S10-20 (SLRRR+) - A2-26 (RR+)
Below 1 Ω
S10-26 (SLRFL-) - A2-28 (FL-)
Below 1 Ω
S7-6 (SLAFR-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S7-7 (SLAFR+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S7-15 (SLARL+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S7-16 (SLRRL+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S7-17 (SLRFR+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S7-26 (SLRRL-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S7-27 (SLARL-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S7-34 (SLRFR-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S10-1 (SLAFL+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S10-2 (SLAFL-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S10-8 (SLRFL+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S10-9 (SLARR-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S10-18 (SLRRR-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S10-19 (SLARR+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S10-20 (SLRRR+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S10-26 (SLRFL-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
5
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (WHEEL CYLINDER PRESSURE SENSOR)
(a) Connect the pedal effort gauge.
BC
BC–150
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
(b) Install the LSPV gauge (SST) and bleed air (see page
BR-3).
SST 09709-29018
(c) Select the DATA LIST mode on the intelligent tester.
Skid control ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
FR PRESS SENS
Front right pressure sensor / Min.:
0 V, Max.: 5 V
When brake pedal is released:
0.3 to 0.9 V
-
FL PRESS SENS
Front left pressure sensor / Min.:
0 V, Max.: 5 V
When brake pedal is released:
0.3 to 0.9 V
-
RR PRESS SENS
Rear right pressure sensor / Min.:
0 V, Max.: 5 V
When brake pedal is released:
0.3 to 0.9 V
-
RL PRESS SENS
Rear left pressure sensor / Min.: 0
V, Max.: 5 V
When brake pedal is released:
0.3 to 0.9 V
-
(d) Check the output value of the wheel cylinder pressure at
each fluid pressure during the ECB control.
Standard voltage
Fluid Pressure
FR PRESS SENS
(DATA-LIST)
FL PRESS SENS
(DATA-LIST)
RR PRESS SENS
(DATA-LIST)
RL PRESS SENS
(DATA-LIST)
1 MPa (10.2 kgf/cm,
145.0 psi)
0.65 to 0.75 V
0.65 to 0.75 V
0.65 to 0.75 V
0.65 to 0.75 V
3 MPa (30.6 kgf/cm,
435.2 psi)
1.05 to 1.2 V
1.05 to 1.2 V
1.05 to 1.2 V
1.05 to 1.2 V
7 MPa (71.4 kgf/cm,
1015.5 psi)
1.8 to 2.05 V
1.8 to 2.05 VV
-
-
10 MPa (102.0 kgf/cm,
1450.7 psi)
2.4 to 2.7 V
2.4 to 2.7
-
-
NG
REPLACE BRAKE ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
OK
6
BC
CHECK BRAKE DISC
(a) Disconnect the brake pedal stroke sensor connector.
(b) Perform the running and braking test according to freeze
frame data or customer problem analysis. Check if the
brake line pressure vibration is due to uneven wear of
the disc according to brake pedal vibration.
OK:
Brake pedal does not vibrate during braking.
HINT:
• The brake pedal does not kick back due to wheel
cylinder piston vibration during ECB control.
• If the brake pedal stroke sensor connector is
disconnected, the fail-safe function prohibits ECB
control.
• The ACTIVE TEST does not prohibit ECB control
when the vehicle is running, so disconnect the stroke
sensor connector and perform the inspection.
• Disc wear can be checked by measuring the disc
thickness.
NG
REPLACE BRAKE DISC
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
BC–151
OK
REPLACE BRAKE ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
BC
BC–152
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
DTC
C1345/66 Linear Solenoid Valve Offset Learning Undone
DTC
C1368/67 Linear Solenoid Valve Offset Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The skid control ECU stores and corrects the difference in each individual part such as the stroke sensor,
actuator solenoids, and stroke simulator solenoid. Perform "initialization of linear solenoid valve and
calibration" if these parts are replaced.
The skid control ECU inputs the shift position P signal.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C1345/66
501
Value of initialization of linear
solenoid valve and calibration for
the FR wheel is not stored.
Initialization of linear solenoid
valve and calibration undone
C1345/66
502
Value of initialization of linear
solenoid valve and calibration for
the FL wheel is not stored.
Initialization of linear solenoid
valve and calibration undone
C1345/66
503
Value of initialization of linear
solenoid valve and calibration for
the RR wheel is not stored.
Initialization of linear solenoid
valve and calibration undone
C1345/66
504
Value of initialization of linear
solenoid valve and calibration for
the RL
Initialization of linear solenoid
valve and calibration undone
C1368/67
505
Wheel is not stored. Value of
initialization of linear solenoid
valve and calibration is not within
the brake actuator's standard
value.
•
•
Initialization of linear solenoid
valve and calibration undone
Skid control ECU
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
PERFORM INITIALIZATION OD LINEAR SOLENOID VALVE AND CALIBRATION
(a) Perform "initialization of linear solenoid valve and
calibration" (see page BC-19).
NEXT
2
RECONFIRM DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (see page BC-38).
(b) Turn the power switch ON (READY).
(c) Check the same DTCs are recorded (see page BC-19).
Result
BC
Result
Proceed to
DTC is not output
A
DTC is output
B
B
A
END
REPLACE BRAKE ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
DTC
BC–153
C1365/54 Accumulator Pressure Sensor Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The accumulator (ACC) pressure sensor is built into the brake actuator.
The skid control ECU detects the accumulator pressure from the data sent from the accumulator pressure
sensor, and then runs and stops the pump motor by operating the motor relay.
DTCs may be output if the accumulator pressure drops due to frequent braking (this is not a malfunction).
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C1365/54
211
Sensor power 1 (VCM1) voltage
is 4.7 V or less or 5.3 V or more
for at least 0.05 sec.
•
•
C1365/54
C1365/54
C1365/54
C1365/54
212
214
215
216
Ratio of accumulator pressure
sensor output voltage (PACC) to
sensor power 1 (VCM1) voltage is
5% or less or 90.5% or more for
at least 0.05 sec.
•
Total wheel cylinder pressure
sensor exceeds 12 MPa after
depressing brake pedal, but
accumulator pressure sensor
output voltage (PACC) changes
less than 0.5 MPa for at least 0.5
sec.
•
Ratio of accumulator pressure
sensor output voltage (PACC) to
sensor power 1 (VCM1) voltage is
90.5% or less for at least 0.1 sec.
during self-diagnosis.
•
Voltage difference is 0.3 V or
more before and after changing
the pull up resistance in sensor
signal input circuit (loose contact).
•
•
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
(accumulator pressure
sensor)
Skid control ECU
Brake actuator assembly
(accumulator pressure
sensor)
Skid control ECU
Brake actuator assembly
(accumulator pressure
sensor)
Skid control ECU
Brake actuator assembly
(accumulator pressure
sensor)
Skid control ECU
Brake actuator assembly
(accumulator pressure
sensor)
Skid control ECU
BC
BC–154
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Brake Actuator
Skid Control ECU
PRL
PRL
PFR
PFR
PMC1
PMC1
PACC
PACC
PCK1
PCK1
E1
VCM1
E2
E
VCM1
E2
PRR
PRR
PFL
PFL
PMC2
PMC2
VCM2
VCM2
PCK2
PCK2
C126252E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
BC
NOTICE:
When replacing the skid control ECU, perform initialization of linear solenoid valve and calibration
(see page BC-19).
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
1
BC–155
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SKID CONTROL ECU - BRAKE ACTUATOR)
(a) Disconnect the S7 ECU connector.
(b) Disconnect the A2 actuator connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Skid Control ECU
Tester Connection
S7
VCM1
PCK1
S7-8 (E) - A2-45 (E1)
Below 1 Ω
S7-9 (VCM1) - A2-35 (VCM1)
Below 1 Ω
S7-21 (PACC) - A2-46 (PACC)
Below 1 Ω
S7-31 (PCK1) - A2-37 (PCK1)
Below 1 Ω
S7-8 (E) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S7-9 (VCM1) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
E
S7-21 (PACC) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
PACC
S7-31 (PCK1) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
Brake Actuator Assembly
A2
Specified Condition
VCM1
PCK1
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
E1
PACC
F047492E11
OK
2
CHECK SKID CONTROL ECU (VCM1 VOLTAGE)
VCM1
(a) Measure the voltage of the connector.
HINT:
Measure the voltage from behind the connector with the
connector connected to the skid control ECU.
Standard voltage
GND
S7
F047485E66
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
S7-9 (VCM1) - S7-1
(GND)
Power switch ON
(READY)
4.75 to 5.25 V
NG
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
OK
3
CHECK SKID CONTROL ECU ASSEMBLY (PACC VOLTAGE)
(a) Check the auxiliary battery voltage.
Standard voltage:
10 to 14 V
BC
BC–156
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
S7
(b) Depress the brake pedal to operate the pump motor, and
then check that the pump motor stops.
(c) Measure the voltage of the connector.
Standard voltage
GND
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S7-21 (PACC) - S7-1 (GND)
3.3 to 4.7 V
NOTICE:
• Do not depress the brake until after the pump
motor stops and the voltage check is finished in
order to keep the accumulator pressure.
• Check from behind the connector with the
connector connected to the skid control ECU.
• Do not use a DATA LIST, as the sensor itself must
be checked.
PACC
F047485E72
NG
REPLACE BRAKE ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
OK
4
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (ACCUMULATOR PRESSURE SENSOR)
(a) Check the DATA LIST for proper functioning of the
accumulator pressure sensor.
(b) Depress the brake pedal 4 or 5 times to operate the
pump motor, and check the output value on the
intelligent tester with the motor stopped (no braking).
Skid control ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
ACC PRESS SENS 1
Accumulator pressure sensor 1 /
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 5 V
Specified value: 3.2 to 4.0 V
-
OK:
Accumulator pressure sensor voltage does not
drop.
NG
OK
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
BC
REPLACE BRAKE ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
DTC
BC–157
C1377/43 Capacitor Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The brake control power supply (capacitor) provides auxiliary power for brake control when the auxiliary
battery (12 V) voltage drops.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C1377/43
101
Brake control power supply
assembly is deteriorated
(indicates a need to replace).
Brake control power supply
C1377/43
102
Self-discharge (current leak) is
excessive (internal malfunction).
Brake control power supply
C1377/43
103
Input voltage from the auxiliary
battery (12 V) to the brake control
power supply is 16.4 V or more
for at least 10 sec.
Brake control power supply
C1377/43
105
Circuit inside the power back up
unit (charge) is malfunctioning.
Brake control power supply
C1377/43
106
Circuit inside the power back up
unit (back up output circuit) is
malfunctioning.
Brake control power supply
C1377/43
108
Circuit inside the power back up
unit (voltage monitor circuit) is
malfunctioning.
Brake control power supply
C1377/43
109
Open circuit between auxiliary
battery (12 V) and brake control
power supply power input (+BC
terminal).
•
•
Harness and connector
ABS MAIN3 fuse
C1377/43
110
When either condition below is
met:
• Open or short circuit between
auxiliary battery (12 V) and
brake control power supply
output 1 (OUT 1).
• Open or short circuit between
auxiliary battery (12 V) and
brake control power supply
output 2 (OUT 2)
•
•
•
Harness and connector
ABS MAIN1 fuse
ABS MAIN2 fuse
BC
BC–158
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Brake Actuator
Skid Control ECU
SMC1
SMC1
SMC2
SMC2
BS2
R2+
ABS NO. 2
SR2
ABS NO. 1
SR1
R1+
BS1
+BI1
+BI2
BC
IG
OUT2
+BO2
OUT
+BO1
GND
BC
+BCTY
BCTY
IG1
Brake Control Power Supply
A
B C D E
F
C126258E02
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
BC–159
F
A B C D E
ECU-IG
IG1
AM1
IG2
AM2
IG2D
P/I
AM2
AM1
IG1D
Power Source
Control ECU
DC/DC
ABS MAIN3
BC
ABS MAIN2
ABS MAIN1
A
B C
D
E
C126250E01
BC–160
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
E
A B C D
IGN
IG2
GND1
GND2
GND3
GND4
GND5
MAIN
GND6
GND1
GND2
C126259E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT FUSE (ABS MAIN3)
(a) Remove the ABS MAIN3 fuse from the engine room
relay block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the fuse.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
Engine Room Relay Block
NG
BC
ABS MAIN3 Fuse
F047764E01
OK
CHECK FOR SHORT IN ALL HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR CONNECTED TO FUSE AND
REPLACE FUSE
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
2
BC–161
CHECK BRAKE CONTROL POWER SUPPLY (BC VOLTAGE)
(a) Measure the voltage of the connector.
HINT:
Measure the voltage from behind the connector with the
connector connected.
Standard voltage
BC
B18
F047500E02
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
B18-8 (BC) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
3
CHECK SKID CONTROL ECU (+BI1, +BI2 VOLTAGE)
+BI1
(a) Measure the voltage of the connectors.
HINT:
Measure the voltage from behind the connector with the
connector connected to the skid control ECU.
Standard voltage
+BI2
S8
S9
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S8-3 (+BI1) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
S9-5 (+BI2) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
F047485E67
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
4
CHECK SKID CONTROL ECU (+BO1, +BO2 VOLTAGE)
(a) Measure the voltage of the connectors.
HINT:
Measure the voltage from behind the connector with the
connector connected to the skid control ECU.
Standard voltage
+BO1
+BO1
S8
S9
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S8-5 (+BO1) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
S9-4 (+BO2) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
F047485E68
NG
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
BC
BC–162
5
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
CHECK BRAKE CONTROL POWER SUPPLY (OUT1, BCTY, OUT2 VOLTAGE)
BCTY
OUT2
OUT
B18
F047500E04
(a)
Measure the voltage of the connector.
HINT:
Measure the voltage from behind the connector with the
connector connected.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
B18-1 (OUT) - Body
ground
Power switch ON
(READY)
9 to 13 V
B18-2 (BCTY) - Body
ground
Power switch ON
(READY)
9 to 13 V
B18-7 (OUT2) - Body
ground
Power switch ON
(READY)
9 to 13 V
NG
REPLACE BRAKE CONTROL POWER
SUPPLY
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
BC
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
DTC
BC–163
C1378/44 Capacitor Communication Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The brake control power supply assembly (capacitor) provides auxiliary power for brake control when an
auxiliary battery (12 V) voltage drops.
The FAIL and ENA line are placed between the skid control ECU and the brake control power supply
assembly. Signals indicating that the brake control power supply is in auxiliary mode are sent to the skid
control ECU through the FAIL line.
Charge permit prohibition signals are sent to the brake control power supply through the ENA line.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C1378/44
112
When either condition below is
met:
• Open or short in FAIL line
• Malfunction inside the power
back up unit
•
•
Harness and connector
Skid control ECU
C1377/43
113
When either condition below is
met:
• Open or short in ENA line
• Malfunction inside the skid
control ECU (circuit for
communication with the
capacitor)
•
•
Harness and connector
Skid control ECU
BC
BC–164
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Skid Control ECU
Brake Control Power Supply
BCTY
+BCTY
ENA
ENA
FAIL
FAIL
OUT2
+BO2
OUT
+BO1
ECU-IG
IG
IG1
Power Source
Control ECU
IG1D
AM1
AM1
DC/DC
BC
ABS MAIN3
MAIN
C126263E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
BC
NOTICE:
When replacing the skid control ECU, perform initialization of linear solenoid valve and calibration
(see page BC-19).
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
1
BC–165
CHECK BRAKE CONTROL POWER SUPPLY (IG VOLTAGE)
(a) Measure the voltage of the connector.
HINT:
Measure the voltage from behind the connector with the
connector connected to the skid control ECU.
Standard voltage
IG
B18
F047500E03
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
B18-5 (IG) - Body
ground
Power switch ON
(READY)
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SKID CONTROL ECU - BRAKE CONTROL POWER SUPPLY)
(a) Disconnect the S8 ECU connector.
(b) Disconnect the B18 supply connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Skid Control ECU
FAIL
S8
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S8-30 (ENA) - B18-12 (ENA)
Below 1 Ω
S8-20 (FAIL) - B18-13 (FAIL)
Below 1 Ω
S8-30 (ENA) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S8-20 (FAIL) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
ENA
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
Brake Control Power Supply
B18
FAIL
BC
ENA
F047501E01
OK
BC–166
3
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
CHECK SKID CONTROL ECU (ENA, FAIL VOLTAGE)
(a) Using an oscilloscope, check the waveform of the skid
control ECU.
OK:
Waveform is output as shown in the illustration.
Waveform (FAIL)
S8
GND2
ENA
GND3
FAIL
Item
Content
Symbols (terminal No.)
S8-20 (FAIL) - S8-1, 2 (GND3, 2)
Tool Setting
5 V/DIV/., 200 ms/DIV.
Condition
Condition READY is displayed on
the meter
Waveform (ENA)
Item
Content
Symbols (terminal No.)
S8-30 (ENA) - S8-1, 2 (GND3, 2)
Tool Setting
5 V/DIV/., 100 ms/DIV.
Condition
Condition READY is displayed on
the meter
GND
Result
Result
C133162E01
A
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
BC
Proceed to
A
Both waveforms are normal
B
Waveform (ENA) is abnormal
C
Waveform (FAIL) is abnormal
B
REPLACE BRAKE CONTROL POWER
SUPPLY
C
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
DTC
BC–167
C1391/69 Accumulator Leak Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
HINT:
The DTC is stored if a brake fluid, internal or other leak is detected due to improper sealing in the actuator.
Internal leakage is suspected if the pump motor operates frequently without braking.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C1391/69
591
Accumulation performance is
deteriorated (improper sealing
inside the actuator, gas pressure
drop inside the accumulator, leak
in each pressure boosting valve).
•
•
Fluid leakage
Brake actuator assembly
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the skid control ECU, perform initialization of linear solenoid valve and calibration
(see page BC-19).
1
CHECK BRAKE FLUID LEAKAGE
(a) Check that there is no fluid leakage in the brake line
between the brake actuator and the wheel cylinder which
is the cause of DTCs.
(b) Check that the brake is not dragging.
OK:
There is no fluid leakage or dragging.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE APPLICABLE PART
OK
2
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (ACCUMULATOR PRESSURE SENSOR)
(a) Check the DATA LIST for proper functioning of the
accumulator pressure sensor.
(b) Depress the brake pedal 4 or 5 times to operate the
pump motor, and check the output value on the
intelligent tester with the motor and check the output
value on the intelligent tester with the motor stopped (no
braking).
Skid control ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
ACC PRESS SENS 1
Accumulator pressure sensor 1 /
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 5 V
Specified value: 3.2 to 4.0 V
-
OK:
Accumulator pressure sensor voltage does not
drop.
NG
REPLACE BRAKE ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
BC
BC–168
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
OK
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
BC
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
BC–169
ABS Warning Light Remains ON
DESCRIPTION
The ABS warning light illuminates to inform the driver that there is a problem in the ABS.
When DTC output is normal and the ABS warning light remains on, perform troubleshooting as indicated
below.
BC
BC–170
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Skid Control ECU
Gateway ECU
CAN-L
CA1L
CA1H
CAN-H
A/C Control Assembly
MPD2
MPX+
MPX2+
Transmission Control ECU
MPX2
MPX1
Certification ECU
MPX1
MPX2
Main Body ECU
MPX1
MPX2
Transponder Key ECU
MPX2
MPX1
Combination Meter
MPX+
MPX-
Power Source Control ECU
MPD1
BC
MPX2
MPX1
to Brake Control Power Supply
BS2
to Brake Control Power Supply
BS1
C126264E01
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
BC–171
SP1Combination
Meter
Power Supply
Circuit
SLIP
BEAN IC
Multiplex
Communication
System
ABS
Brake Control Warning
VSC
IG1
Power Source Control ECU
GAUGE
IG1D
AM1
AM1
BC
DC/DC
MAIN
DOME
C126265E01
BC–172
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the skid control ECU, perform initialization of linear solenoid valve and calibration
(see page BC-19).
1
CHECK SKID CONTROL ECU (BS1, BS2 VOLTAGE)
BS1
S7
(a) Measure the voltage of the connectors.
HINT:
Measure the voltage from behind the connector with the
connector connected to the skid control ECU.
Standard voltage
BS2
S10
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S7-3 (BS1) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
S10-7 (BS2) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
F047485E70
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
2
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (ABS WARNING LIGHT)
(a) Select the ACTIVE TEST, generate a control command,
and then check that the ABS warning light operates.
Skid control ECU
Item
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
ABS WARN LIGHT
Turns ABS warning light ON / OFF
Observe combination meter
OK:
The ABS warning light turns on or off.
NG
OK
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
BC
REPAIR OR REPLACE COMBINATION
METER ASSEMBLY
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
BC–173
ABS Warning Light does not Come ON
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
(a) Check if a CAN communication system DTC is output
(see page CA-16).
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC is not output
A
DTC is output
B
B
REPAIR CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
A
2
CHECK MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
(a) Check if a multiplex communication system DTC is
output (see page MP-7).
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC is not output
A
DTC is output
B
B
REPAIR MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION
SYSTEM
A
REPAIR OR REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
BC
BC–174
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
VSC Warning Light Remains ON
DESCRIPTION
The VSC warning light illuminates to inform the driver that there is a problem in the Enhanced VSC. When
DTC output is normal and the VSC warning light remains on, perform troubleshooting as indicated below.
BC
BC–175
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Gateway ECU
Skid Control ECU
CA1L
CAN-L
CA1H
CAN-H
A/C Control Assembly
MPD2
MPX+
MPX2+
Transmission Control ECU
MPX2
MPX1
Certification ECU
MPX1
MPX2
Main Body ECU
MPX1
MPX2
Transponder Key ECU
MPX2
MPX1
Combination Meter
MPX+
MPX-
Power Source Control ECU
MPD1
MPX2
MPX1
BC
C126266E01
BC–176
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
SP1Combination
Meter
Power Supply
Circuit
SLIP
BEAN IC
Multiplex
Communication
System
ABS
Brake Control Warning
VSC
IG1
Power Source Control ECU
GAUGE
IG1D
AM1
AM1
BC
DC/DC
MAIN
DOME
C126265E01
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
BC–177
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the skid control ECU, perform initialization of linear solenoid valve and calibration
(see page BC-19).
1
CHECK SKID CONTROL ECU CONNECTOR
(a) Check the skid control ECU connector's connecting
condition.
OK:
The connector should be securely connected.
NG
CONNECT CONNECTOR TO ECU
CORRECTLY
OK
2
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (VSC WARNING LIGHT)
(a) Select the ACTIVE TEST, generate a control command,
and then check that the VSC warning light operates.
Skid control ECU
Item
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
VSC WARN LIGHT
Turns VSC warning light ON / OFF
Observe combination meter
OK:
The VSC warning light turns on or off.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE COMBINATION
METER ASSEMBLY
OK
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
BC
BC–178
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
VSC Warning Light does not Come ON
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
(a) Check if a CAN communication system DTC is output
(see page CA-16).
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC is not output
A
DTC is output
B
B
REPAIR CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
A
2
CHECK MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
(a) Check if a multiplex communication system DTC is
output (see page MP-7).
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC is not output
A
DTC is output
B
B
REPAIR MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION
SYSTEM
A
REPAIR OR REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
BC
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
BC–179
Brake Warning Light Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The BRAKE warning light comes on when the brake fluid is insufficient or the parking brake is applied.
The skid control ECU is connected to the combination meter via the CAN and multiplex communications.
When the DTC is normal and BRAKE warning light remains on, perform troubleshooting as indicated
below.
BC
BC–180
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Gateway ECU
Skid Control ECU
CA1L
CAN-L
CA1H
CAN-H
A/C Control Assembly
MPD2
MPX+
MPX2+
Transmission Control ECU
MPX2
MPX1
Certification ECU
MPX1
MPX2
Main Body ECU
MPX1
MPX2
Transponder Key ECU
MPX2
MPX1
Combination Meter
MPX+
MPX-
Power Source Control ECU
BC
MPD1
MPX2
MPX1
C126266E01
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
BC–181
SP1-
Combination Meter
Power Supply
Circuit
BEAN IC
Multiplex
Communication
System
Brake Warning
IG1
GAUGE
Power Source Control ECU
IG1D
AM1
AM1
Brake Fluid Level Warning Switch
DC/DC
LBL
DOME
MAIN
BC
Parking Brake Switch
PKB
C126267E01
BC–182
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the skid control ECU, perform initialization of linear solenoid valve and calibration
(see page BC-19).
1
CHECK BRAKE FLUID LEVEL IN RESERVOIR
(a) Check that the brake fluid level is sufficient.
HINT:
• If the fluid level drops, check for a fluid leak, and
repair if found.
• If no leaks exist, add and adjust fluid and then check
that the trouble code is not output again.
OK:
Brake fluid level is proper.
NG
ADD BRAKE FLUID
OK
2
CHECK DTC FOR ABS
Check if the DTCs are recorded (see page BC-38).
OK
REPAIR CIRCUIT INDICATED BY OUTPUT
CODE
NG
3
INSPECT PARKING BRAKE SWITCH ASSEMBLY
Not Pushed
Pushed
(a) Remove the parking brake switch connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the switch.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
1
BC
OK
Specified Condition
P2-1 - Ground part
Not pushed
Below 1 Ω
P2-1 - Ground part
Pushed
10 kΩ or higher
NG
G026238E17
Switch Condition
REPLACE PARKING BRAKE SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
4
BC–183
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SKID CONTROL ECU - PARKING BRAKE SWITCH)
(a) Disconnect the S9 ECU connector.
(b) Disconnect the P3 switch connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Skid Control ECU
PKB
S9
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S9-14 (PKB) - P3-1 (PKB)
Below 1 Ω
S9-14 (PKB) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
Parking Brake Switch
PKB
C126278E01
OK
5
INSPECT BRAKE FLUID LEVEL WARNING SWITCH
(a) Remove the reservoir tank cap and strainer.
(b) Disconnect the brake fluid level warning switch
connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the switch.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Fluid Level
Specified Condition
1-2
Proper
1.8 to 2.16 kΩ
1-2
Below minimum level
10 kΩ or higher
G026237E07
NG
REPLACE BRAKE FLUID LEVEL WARNING
SWITCH
BC
OK
6
INSPECT SKID CONTROL ECU CONNECTOR
(a) Check the skid control ECU connector's connecting
condition.
OK:
The connector should be securely connected.
NG
CONNECT CONNECTOR TO ECU
CORRECTLY
BC–184
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
OK
7
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (BRAKE WARNING LIGHT)
(a) Select the ACTIVE TEST, generate a control command,
and then check that the brake warning light operates.
Skid control ECU
Item
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
BRAKE WARN LIGHT
Turns BRAKE warning light ON / OFF
Observe combination meter
OK:
The brake warning light turns on or off.
NG
OK
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
BC
REPAIR OR REPLACE COMBINATION
METER ASSEMBLY
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
BC–185
Brake Control Warning Light Remains ON
DESCRIPTION
The skid control ECU is connected to the combination meter via the CAN and multiplex communications.
The brake control warning light illuminates to inform the driver that there is a problem in the ECB, or a
problem in the brake system that has no influence on driving.
BC
BC–186
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Skid Control ECU
Gateway ECU
CAN-L
CA1L
CA1H
CAN-H
A/C Control Assembly
MPD2
MPX+
MPX2+
Transmission Control ECU
MPX2
MPX1
Certification ECU
MPX1
MPX2
Main Body ECU
MPX1
MPX2
Transponder Key ECU
MPX2
MPX1
Combination Meter
MPX+
MPX-
Power Source Control ECU
MPD1
BC
MPX2
MPX1
to Brake Control Power Supply
BS2
to Brake Control Power Supply
BS1
C126264E01
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
BC–187
SP1Combination
Meter
Power Supply
Circuit
SLIP
BEAN IC
Multiplex
Communication
System
ABS
Brake Control Warning
VSC
IG1
Power Source Control ECU
GAUGE
IG1D
AM1
AM1
BC
DC/DC
MAIN
DOME
C126265E01
BC–188
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the skid control ECU, perform initialization of linear solenoid valve and calibration
(see page BC-19).
1
CHECK SKID CONTROL ECU (BS1, BS2 VOLTAGE)
BS1
S7
(a) Measure the voltage of the connectors.
HINT:
Measure the voltage from behind the connector with the
connector connected to the skid control ECU.
BS2
S10
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S7-3 (BS1) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
S10-7 (BS2) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
F047485E70
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
2
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (BRAKE CONTROL WARNING
LIGHT)
(a) Select the ACTIVE TEST, generate a control command,
and then check that the brake control warning light
operates.
Skid control ECU
Item
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
ECB INDI LIGHT
Turns Brake Control warning light ON / OFF
Observe combination meter
OK:
The brake control warning light turns on or off.
NG
OK
BC
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
REPAIR OR REPLACE COMBINATION
METER
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
BC–189
Brake Control Warning Light does not Come ON
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
(a) Check if a CAN communication system DTC is output
(see page CA-6).
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC is not output
A
DTC is output
B
B
REPAIR CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
A
2
CHECK MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
(a) Check if a multiplex communication system DTC is
output (see page MP-7 ).
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC is not output
A
DTC is output
B
B
REPAIR MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION
SYSTEM
A
REPAIR OR REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
BC
BC–190
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
Slip Indicator Light Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The SLIP indicator blinks during Enhanced VSC operation.
The skid control ECU is connected to the combination meter via the CAN and multiplex communications.
BC
BC–191
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Gateway ECU
Skid Control ECU
CA1L
CAN-L
CA1H
CAN-H
A/C Control Assembly
MPD2
MPX+
MPX2+
Transmission Control ECU
MPX2
MPX1
Certification ECU
MPX1
MPX2
Main Body ECU
MPX1
MPX2
Transponder Key ECU
MPX2
MPX1
Combination Meter
MPX+
MPX-
Power Source Control ECU
MPD1
MPX2
MPX1
BC
C126266E01
BC–192
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
SP1Combination
Meter
Power Supply
Circuit
SLIP
BEAN IC
Multiplex
Communication
System
ABS
Brake Control Warning
VSC
IG1
Power Source Control ECU
GAUGE
IG1D
AM1
AM1
BC
DC/DC
MAIN
DOME
C126265E01
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
BC–193
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the skid control ECU, perform initialization of linear solenoid valve and calibration
(see page BC-19).
1
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (SLIP INDICATOR LIGHT)
(a) Select the ACTIVE TEST, generate a control command,
and then check that the SLIP indicator light operates.
Skid control ECU
Item
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
SLIP INDI LIGHT
Turns SLIP indicator light ON / OFF
Observe combination meter
OK:
Turn the SLIP indicator light on or off.
OK
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
NG
2
CHECK CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
(a) Check if a CAN communication system DTC is output
(see page CA-16).
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC is not output
A
DTC is output
B
B
REPAIR CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
A
3
CHECK MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
(a) Check if a multiplex communication system DTC is
output.
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC is not output
A
DTC is output
B
B
REPAIR MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION
SYSTEM
A
REPAIR OR REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
BC
BC–194
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
Skid Control Buzzer Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The skid control buzzer sounds and VSC warning light comes ON during Enhanced VSC operation.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Skid Control Buzzer
Skid Control ECU
VBZ
VBZ
BZ
BZ
GND
GND2
GND3
GND4
GND5
GND6
C126268E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the skid control ECU, perform initialization of linear solenoid valve and calibration
(see page BC-19).
BC
1
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (SKID CONTROL BUZZER)
(a) Select the ACTIVE TEST, generate a control command,
and then check that the skid control buzzer operates.
Skid control ECU
Item
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
VSC/BR WARN BUZ
Turns VSC / BRAKE warning buzzer ON /
OFF
Buzzer can be heard
OK:
The skid control buzzer can be heard.
OK
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
BC–195
NG
2
INSPECT SKID CONTROL BUZZER ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the skid control buzzer connector.
(b) Apply a battery positive voltage to terminals 1 and 2 of
the skid control buzzer connector, and check that the
buzzer sounds.
OK:
The skid control buzzer sound should be heard.
2
1
(-)
(+)
NG
REPLACE SKID CONTROL BUZZER
ASSEMBLY
F002192E11
OK
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SKID CONTROL ECU - SKID CONTROL BUZZER)
(a) Disconnect the S8 ECU connector.
(b) Disconnect the S6 buzzer connectors.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Skid Control ECU
S8
VBZ
BZ
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S8-33 (VBZ) - S6-2 (VBZ)
Below 1 Ω
S8-12 (BZ) - S6-1 (BZ)
Below 1 Ω
S8-33 (VBZ) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
S8-12 (BZ) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
Skid Control Buzzer
S6
BZ
VBZ
C126279E01
OK
BC
BC–196
4
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SKID CONTROL ECU - BODY GROUND)
GND4
GND1
GND2
S7
GND3
S8
S9
GND5
GND6
S10
F047485E71
(a) Measure the resistance of the connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S7-1 (GND1) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
S8-2 (GND2) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
S8-1 (GND3) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
S9-2 (GND4) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
S9-1 (GND5) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
S10-4 (GND6) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
OK
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU ASSEMBLY
BC
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
BC–197
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
TC and CG Terminal Circuit
DESCRIPTION
Connecting terminals TC and CG of the DLC3 causes the ECU to display DTCs by flashing the ABS
warning light.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Gateway ECU
Skid Control ECU
CA1L
CA1H
ECM
CANL
CAN-L
CANH
CAN-H
DLC3
TC
TC
CG
BC
C126269E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the skid control ECU, perform initialization of linear solenoid valve and calibration
(see page BC-19).
BC–198
1
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
CHECK DLC3 (TC VOLTAGE)
(a) Turn the power switch ON (READY).
(b) Measure the voltage of the DLC3 connector.
Standard voltage
CG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D1-13 (TC) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
(c) Measure the resistance of the DLC3 connector.
Standard resistance
TC
C108847E02
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D1-4 (CG) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
Go to step 3
OK
2
CHECK CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
(a) Check if a CAN communication system DTC is output
(see page CA-6).
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC is not output
A
DTC is output
B
B
A
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
BC
REPAIR CIRCUIT INDICATED BY OUTPUT
CODE
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
3
BC–199
CHECK WIRE HARNESS AND CONNECTORS (DLC3 - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the slid control ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
D1
DLC3
TC
Skid Control ECU
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D1-13 (TC) - E6-14 (TC)
Below 1 Ω
D1-13 (TC) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
E6
TC
C133168E01
OK
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (DLC3 - BODY GROUND)
(a) Measure the resistance of the DLC3 connector.
Standard resistance
D1
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D1-4 (CG) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
CG
H100769E69
OK
BC
5
CHECK CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
(a) Check if a CAN communication system DTC is output
(see page CA-6).
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC is not output
A
DTC is output
B
BC–200
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
B
A
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
BC
REPAIR CIRCUIT INDICATED BY OUTPUT
CODE
BC–201
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
TS and CG Terminal Circuit
DESCRIPTION
In the sensor check mode, a malfunction of the speed sensor that cannot be detected when the vehicle is
stopped is detected while driving.
Transition to the sensor check mode can be performed by connecting terminals TS and CG of the DLC3
and turning the power switch from OFF to ON (READY).
WIRING DIAGRAM
Skid Control ECU
DLC3
TS
TS
CG
C126270E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
When replacing the skid control ECU, perform initialization of linear solenoid valve and calibration
(see page BC-19).
BC
BC–202
1
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
CHECK DLC3 (TS VOLTAGE)
(a) Turn the power switch ON (READY).
(b) Measure the voltage of the DLC3.
Standard voltage
CG
D1
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D1-12 (TS) - D1-4 (CG)
10 to 14 V
NG
Go to step 3
TS
C108847E38
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SKID CONTROL ECU - DLC3)
(a) Disconnect the S8 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Skid Control ECU
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S8-32 (TS) - D1-12 (TS)
Below 1 Ω
S8-32 (TS) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
S8
TS
D1
DLC3
TS
OK
BC
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
C133169E01
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
BRAKE CONTROL – ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
3
BC–203
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (DLC3 - BODY GROUND)
(a) Measure the resistance of the DLC3 connector.
Standard resistance
D1
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D1-4 (CG) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
CG
H100769E69
OK
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SKID CONTROL ECU - DLC3)
(a) Disconnect the S8 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Skid Control ECU
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S8-32 (TS) - D1-12 (TS)
Below 1 Ω
S8-32 (TS) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
S8
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
TS
D1
DLC3
TS
C133169E01
OK
BC
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
BC–201
BRAKE CONTROL – BRAKE ACTUATOR
BRAKE ACTUATOR
BRAKE CONTROL
COMPONENTS
WINDSHIELD WIPER
ARM COVER
21 (214, 16)
21 (214, 16)
x2
FRONT WIPER ARM RH
FRONT WIPER ARM LH
HOOD TO COWL TOP SEAL
COWL TOP VENTILATOR
LOUVER RH
CLIP
COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER LH
CLIP
x5
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR
AND LINK ASSEMBLY
WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR
CONNECTOR
x7
8.4 (86, 74 in.*lbf)
6.4 (65, 57 in.*lbf)
BC
x2
ENGINE ROOM NO. 2 RELAY BLOCK
OUTER FRONT COWL TOP PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C127337E01
BC–202
BRAKE CONTROL – BRAKE ACTUATOR
INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
C127338E01
BC
BC–203
BRAKE CONTROL – BRAKE ACTUATOR
BRAKE ACTUATOR CONNECTOR
NO. 1 FRONT BRAKE TUBE
BRAKE ACTUATOR HOSE
BRAKE ACTUATOR TUBE
8.5 (87, 75 in.*lbf)
15 (155, 11)
15 (155, 11)
15 (155, 11)
15 (155, 11)
BRAKE TUBE
20 (200, 15)
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
BRAKE ACTUATOR WITH BRACKET
15 (155, 11)
NO. 5 FRONT BRAKE TUBE
BC
CLIP
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C127339E01
BC–204
BRAKE CONTROL – BRAKE ACTUATOR
18 (184, 13)
18 (184, 13)
BRACKET
BRAKE ACTUATOR
NO. 2 BRAKE ACTUATOR
BRACKET
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
18 (184, 13)
GUSSET
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
BRAKE ACTUATOR DAMPER
BC
18 (184, 13)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C127340E01
BRAKE CONTROL – BRAKE ACTUATOR
BC–205
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT BRAKE ACTUATOR OPERATION
(a) Pre-check preparation
(1) Move the shift lever to the P position. Apply the
parking brake and connect the intelligent tester
to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(3) Turn on the intelligent tester. Select "MAS CYL
PRS 1", "MAS CYL PRS 2", "FR PRESS
SENS", "FL PRESS SENS", "RR PRESS
SENS" and "RL PRESS SENS".
(b) Check FR system solenoid (SLA**, SLR**, SMC1,
SMC2)
(1) Select "SLAFR CUR". → Set the current to 1.2
A. → Check the output voltage.
NOTICE:
Do not depress the brake pedal.
HINT:
It takes approximately 35 seconds to complete
the check.
If incorrect, troubleshoot the brake system (see
page BC-28).
Standard output voltage
Sensor
10 to 20 sec. after check start
(V)
35 sec. or more after check start
(V)
MAS CYL PRS 1
0.3 to 0.7
0.3 to 0.7
MAS CYL PRS 2
0.3 to 0.7
0.3 to 0.7
FR PRESS SENS
2.5 to 4.5
0.3 to 0.7
FL PRESS SENS
0.3 to 0.7
0.3 to 0.7
RR PRESS SENS
0.3 to 0.7
0.3 to 0.7
RL PRESS SENS
0.3 to 0.7
0.3 to 0.7
(c) Check FL system solenoid (SLA**, SLR**, SMC1,
SMC2)
(1) Select "SLAFL CUR". → Set the current to 1.2
A. → Check the output voltage.
NOTICE:
Do not depress the brake pedal.
HINT:
It takes approximately 35 seconds to complete
the check.
If incorrect, troubleshoot the brake system (see
page BC-28).
Standard output voltage
Sensor
10 to 20 sec. after check start
(V)
35 sec. or more after check start
(V)
MAS CYL PRS 1
0.3 to 0.7
0.3 to 0.7
MAS CYL PRS 2
0.3 to 0.7
0.3 to 0.7
FR PRESS SENS
0.3 to 0.7
0.3 to 0.7
FL PRESS SENS
2.5 to 4.5
0.3 to 0.7
RR PRESS SENS
0.3 to 0.7
0.3 to 0.7
RL PRESS SENS
0.3 to 0.7
0.3 to 0.7
BC
BC–206
BRAKE CONTROL – BRAKE ACTUATOR
(d) Check RR system solenoid (SLA**, SLR**, SMC1,
SMC2)
(1) Select "SLARR CUR". → Set the current to 1.2
A. → Check the output voltage.
NOTICE:
Do not depress the brake pedal.
HINT:
It takes approximately 35 seconds to complete
the check.
If incorrect, troubleshoot the brake system (see
page BC-28).
Standard output voltage
Sensor
10 to 20 sec. after check start
(V)
35 sec. or more after check start
(V)
MAS CYL PRS 1
0.3 to 0.7
0.3 to 0.7
MAS CYL PRS 2
0.3 to 0.7
0.3 to 0.7
FR PRESS SENS
0.3 to 0.7
0.3 to 0.7
FL PRESS SENS
0.3 to 0.7
0.3 to 0.7
RR PRESS SENS
2.5 to 4.5
0.3 to 0.7
RL PRESS SENS
0.3 to 0.7
0.3 to 0.7
(e) Check RL system solenoid (SLA**, SLR**, SMC1,
SMC2)
(1) Select "SLARL CUR". → Set the current to 1.2
A. → Check the output voltage.
NOTICE:
Do not depress the brake pedal.
HINT:
It takes approximately 35 seconds to complete
the check.
If incorrect, troubleshoot the brake system (see
page BC-28).
Standard output voltage
Sensor
10 to 20 sec. after check start
(V)
35 sec. or more after check start
(V)
MAS CYL PRS 1
0.3 to 0.7
0.3 to 0.7
MAS CYL PRS 2
0.3 to 0.7
0.3 to 0.7
FR PRESS SENS
0.3 to 0.7
0.3 to 0.7
FL PRESS SENS
0.3 to 0.7
0.3 to 0.7
RR PRESS SENS
0.3 to 0.7
0.3 to 0.7
RL PRESS SENS
2.5 to 4.5
0.3 to 0.7
(f)
BC
Check SMC1, SMC2
(1) Select and enter "ECB INVALID" to prohibit the
brake control (ECB) on the intelligent tester
menu screen.
(2) Check that the ECB warning light comes on.
(3) Check the output voltage by depressing the
brake pedal.
Standard difference in output voltage
Sensor
Specified Condition
Between "MAS CYL PRES 1" and "FR PRESS SENS"
Less than 0.4 V
Between "MAS CYL PRES 2" and "FL PRESS SENS"
Less than 0.4 V
BC–207
BRAKE CONTROL – BRAKE ACTUATOR
(4) Press the return key on the intelligent tester
and cancel brake control prohibition (ECB
INVALID).
2.
Pedal Effort Gauge
SST
SST
F046639E01
INSPECT PRESSURE SENSOR OPERATION
(a) Check battery voltage.
Standard battery voltage:
10 to 14 V (during engine stop)
(b) Connect the hydro booster pressure gauge and
pedal effort gauge.
(1) Install the LSPV gauge (SST) and brake pedal
effort gauge.
SST 09709-29018
(2) Bleed the air out of the hydro booster pressure
gauge.
(3) Move the shift lever to the P position. Connect
intelligent tester to the DLC3 with the parking
brake applied.
(4) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(5) Clear the DTC (see page BC-38).
(c) Check wheel cylinder pressure sensor and master
pressure sensor.
(1) Turn on the intelligent tester. Select "MAS CYL
PRS 1", "MAS CYL PRS 2", "FR PRESS
SENS", "FL PRESS SENS", "RR PRESS
SENS" and "RL PRESS SENS".
(2) Check the brake effort, pressure gauge
reading, and output pressure voltage.
If incorrect, troubleshoot the brake system (see
page BC-28).
Standard output voltage
Brake effort
N (kgf, lbf)
MAS CYL PRS 1
(V)
MAS CYL PRS 2
(V)
200 (20.4, 45)
0.9 to 1.2
0.9 to 1.2
500 (51, 112)
1.7 to 2.2
1.7 to 2.2
Brake effort
N (kgf, lbf)
Front right wheel
hydraulic pressure
FR PRESS SENS
(V)
MPa (kgf/cm2, psi)
50 (5.1, 11)
3.6 (36.4, 518)
1.15 to 1.35
100 (10.2, 22)
6.9 (70.0, 996)
1.8 to 2.0
150 (15.3, 34)
9.1 (93.3, 1,327)
2.25 to 2.45
200 (20.4, 45)
11.4 (115.9, 1,648)
2.65 to 2.95
Brake effort
N (kgf, lbf)
Front left wheel
hydraulic pressure
FL PRESS SENS
(V)
MPa (kgf/cm2, psi)
50 (5.1, 11)
3.6 (36.4, 518)
1.15 to 1.35
100 (10.2, 22)
6.9 (70.0, 996)
1.8 to 2.0
150 (15.3, 34)
9.1 (93.3, 1,327)
2.25 to 2.45
200 (20.4, 45)
11.4 (115.9, 1,648)
2.65 to 2.95
BC
BC–208
BRAKE CONTROL – BRAKE ACTUATOR
Brake effort
N (kgf, lbf)
Rear right wheel
hydraulic pressure
RR PRESS SENS
(V)
MPa (kgf/cm2, psi)
50 (5.1, 11)
3.9 (39.4, 560)
1.2 to 1.4
100 (10.2, 22)
4 (40.8, 580)
1.25 to 1.5
150 (15.3, 34)
4 (40.8, 580)
1.25 to 1.5
200 (20.4, 45)
4 (40.8, 580)
1.25 to 1.5
Brake effort
N (kgf, lbf)
Rear left wheel
hydraulic pressure
RL PRESS SENS
(V)
MPa (kgf/cm2, psi)
50 (5.1, 11)
3.9 (39.4, 560)
1.2 to 1.4
100 (10.2, 22)
4 (40.8, 580)
1.25 to 1.5
150 (15.3, 34)
4 (40.8, 580)
1.25 to 1.5
200 (20.4, 45)
4 (40.8, 580)
1.25 to 1.5
(d) Check accumulator (ACC) pressure sensor.
(1) Move the shift lever to the P position. Apply the
parking brake and connect the intelligent tester.
(2) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(3) Turn on the intelligent tester. Select the
accumulator (ACC) pressure sensor 1 ("ACC
PRESS SENS").
(4) Temporarily operate the pump motor by
depressing the brake pedal 4 to 5 times.
(5) After confirming that the pump motor stops,
check the pressure output voltage.
If incorrect, troubleshoot the brake system (see
page BC-28).
Standard output voltage:
2.6 to 3.8 V
BC
BRAKE CONTROL – BRAKE ACTUATOR
BC–209
REPLACEMENT
NOTICE:
Be sure to replace the actuator and the resistor together.
If they are not replaced together, motor noise may be
increased.
1.
REPLACE BRAKE ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the windshield wiper motor and link (see
page WW-13).
HINT:
Refer to the procedures from the removal of the
front wiper arm LH/RH up until the removal of the
windshield wiper motor and link assembly.
(b) Perform the accumulator pressure "ZERO DOWN"
operation.
NOTICE:
Carry out the accumulator "ZERO DOWN"
operation and lower the internal pressure before
removing the brake actuator.
(1) Move the shift lever to the P position. Apply the
parking brake and connect the intelligent tester
to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(3) Turn on the intelligent tester. Select "ZERO
DOWN".
NOTICE:
Keep the fluid inside the reservoir above the
"LOW" level by replenishing.
HINT:
• Accumulator pressure is released and
accumulated repeatedly, which circulates
the fluid inside the accumulator when
performing this procedure.
• The pump motor rotates and the
accumulator is pressurized every time
turning the power switch from OFF to ON
(IG).
(4) Turn the power switch OFF.
(c) Set the brake control (ECB) off.
NOTICE:
• Prohibit the brake control (ECB) before air
bleeding.
• Be sure to remove the No. 1 and No. 2 motor
relays first, then the brake actuator.
BC
BC–210
BRAKE CONTROL – BRAKE ACTUATOR
F046145E01
(1) With the power switch OFF to prohibit brake
control, remove the No. 1 and No. 2 motor
relays.
NOTICE:
If the pump motor operates while there is air
remaining inside the brake actuator hose,
the air will enter the actuator, resulting in
difficulty in air bleeding.
(d) Remove the outer front cowl top panel (see page
BR-28).
(e) Remove the inverter with converter (see page HV530).
HINT:
Refer to the procedures from the removal of the
engine under cover LH up until the removal of the
inverter with converter.
(f) Drain brake fluid.
NOTICE:
Wash brake fluid off immediately if it adheres to
any painted surface.
(g) Separate the water pump with motor and bracket.
(1) Disconnect the connector.
(2) Remove the 2 bolts and disconnect the water
pump from the gusset.
F046171E01
(3) Remove the 2 clamps, bolt and heater hose
bracket from the gusset.
F046172E01
(h) Remove the brake actuator with bracket.
(1) Release the lock and disconnect the brake
actuator connector.
(2) Remove the clip and disconnect the No. 2
brake actuator hose from the brake actuator.
BC
F046173E01
BRAKE CONTROL – BRAKE ACTUATOR
Bolt
BC–211
(3) Using SST, disconnect the No. 5 front brake
tube from the brake actuator and front brake
flexible hose.
SST 09023-00101
(4) Remove the bolt and No. 5 front brake tube
from the bracket of the brake actuator.
F046174E01
(5) Using SST, disconnect the No. 1 front brake
tube.
SST 09023-00101
(6) Remove the bolt and No. 1 front brake tube
from the bracket of the brake actuator.
Bolt
F046150E01
(7) Remove the 3 nuts and brake actuator tubes
from the brake stroke simulator cylinder and
brake actuator.
F046184E01
BC
(8) Remove the bolt from the brake actuator.
(9) Using SST, remove the 4 brake tubes from the
brake stroke simulator cylinder and brake
actuator.
SST 09023-00101
F046176E01
BC–212
BRAKE CONTROL – BRAKE ACTUATOR
(10) Remove the bolt, 2 nuts and brake actuator
with gusset.
F046177E01
(i)
Remove the brake actuator.
(1) Remove the 2 bolts and brake actuator
damper.
G028780E01
(2) Remove the bolt, nut and bracket from the
brake actuator.
G028781E01
(3) Remove the 2 nuts, bolt and brake actuator
from the gusset.
BC
G030216E01
(4) Remove the bolt and No. 2 brake actuator
bracket from the brake actuator.
G028782E01
BRAKE CONTROL – BRAKE ACTUATOR
(j)
Pin
BC–213
Install the brake actuator.
(1) Aligning the positioning pin, install the No. 2
brake actuator bracket to the brake actuator
with the bolt.
Torque: 18 N*m (184 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
G028783E01
3
1
Pin
2
(2) Aligning the positioning pin, install the brake
actuator to the gusset with the 2 nuts and bolt.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (76 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Tighten the nuts and bolt in the order
shown in the illustration.
F046178E03
(3) Install the bracket to the brake actuator with the
bolt and nut.
Torque: 18 N*m (184 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Tighten the nut and bolt in the order shown
in the illustration.
2
1
G028781E02
(4) Install the brake actuator damper to the brake
actuator with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 18 N*m (184 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Tighten the bolts in the order shown in the
illustration.
2
1
G028780E02
(k) Install the brake actuator with bracket.
(1) Install the brake actuator with gusset with the
bolt and 2 nuts.
Torque: 20 N*m (200 kgf*cm, 15 ft.*lbf)
F046177E01
BC
BC–214
BRAKE CONTROL – BRAKE ACTUATOR
(2) Using SST, install the 4 brake tubes to the
brake stroke simulator cylinder and brake
actuator.
SST 09023-00101
Torque: 15 N*m (155 kgf*cm, 11 ft.*lbf)
(3) Set the brake tube with the clamp bracket bolt.
Torque: 5.0 N*m (51 kgf*cm, 44 in.*lbf)
F046176E01
(4) Install the brake actuator tube with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 8.5 N*m (87 kgf*cm, 75 in.*lbf)
G028784E01
(5) Set the brake actuator tube with the nut.
Torque: 8.5 N*m (87 kgf*cm, 75 in.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Press the brake actuator tube so that there
is no clearance between the bracket and the
actuator tube as shown in the illustration,
and tighten the nut.
Clearance: 0 mm (0 in.)
G028785E02
(6) Using SST, install the No. 1 front brake tube to
the brake actuator and 2-way.
SST 09023-00101
Torque: 15 N*m (155 kgf*cm, 11 ft.*lbf)
(7) Install the No. 1 front brake tube to the bracket
of the brake actuator with the bolt.
Torque: 5.0 N*m (51 kgf*cm, 44 in.*lbf)
Bolt
BC
F046150E01
BRAKE CONTROL – BRAKE ACTUATOR
BC–215
(8) Using SST, connect the No. 5 front brake tube.
SST 09023-00101
Torque: 15 N*m (155 kgf*cm, 11 ft.*lbf)
(9) Install the bracket of the No. 5 front brake tube
with the bolt.
Torque: 5.0 N*m (51 kgf*cm, 44 in.*lbf)
Bolt
F046174E01
(10) Connect the brake actuator connector and fix it
with the lock.
(11) Install the No. 2 brake actuator hose to the
brake actuator with the clip.
G030217E01
(l)
Connect the water pump with motor and bracket.
(1) Install the heater hose bracket to the gusset
with the 2 clamps and bolt.
F046172E01
A
B
F046171E02
BC
(2) Install the heater water pump with the 2 bolts.
NOTICE:
Tighten bolt A and then bolt B.
(3) Connect the heater water pump connector.
(m) Install the inverter with converter (see page HV535).
HINT:
Refer to the procedures from the installation of the
inverter with converter up until the installation of the
engine under cover LH.
BC–216
BRAKE CONTROL – BRAKE ACTUATOR
(n) Install the outer front cowl top panel (see page BR32).
(o) Install the windshield wiper motor and link (see page
WW-15).
HINT:
Refer to the procedures from the installation of the
windshield wiper motor and link assembly up until
the installation of the front wiper arm LH/RH.
2.
REPLACE BRAKE ACTUATOR RESISTOR
(a) Remove the instrument panel (see page IP-5).
HINT:
Refer to the procedures from the removal of the No.
1 instrument panel register assembly up until the
removal of the instrument panel sub-assembly.
(b) Remove the brake actuator resistor.
(1) Remove the nut.
(2) Disconnect the connector and remove the
resistor.
F048521E01
(c) Install the brake actuator resistor.
(1) Connect the connector and install the resistor.
(2) Install the nut.
Torque: 5.0 N*m (51 kgf*cm, 44 in.*lbf)
(d) Install the instrument panel (see page IP-11).
HINT:
Refer to the procedures from the installation of the
instrument panel sub-assembly up until the
installation of the No. 1 instrument panel register
assembly.
F048521E01
BC
3.
FILL RESERVOIR WITH BRAKE FLUID (See page BR5)
4.
BLEED AIR FROM BRAKE ACTUATOR (See page
BR-8)
5.
CHECK FOR BRAKE FLUID LEAKAGE
6.
CHECK FLUID LEVEL IN RESERVOIR
7.
CHECK AND CLEAR DTC
(a) Check and clear the DTC (see page BC-38).
8.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
BRAKE CONTROL – BRAKE ACTUATOR
9.
BC–217
PERFORM SYSTEM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform the brake system initialization (see page
BC-19).
10. PERFORM ACTIVE TEST
(a) Perform the Active Test (see page BC-43).
DISPOSAL
Radius of the middle of A
1.
F046643E06
DISPOSE OF BRAKE ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a drill, slowly make a hole at the radius
indicated at the middle of A in the illustration and
bleed the charged gas.
CAUTION:
Be sure to wear protective glasses as fragments
may fly out due to pressure.
HINT:
• The hole may be drilled up to approximately 5 to
10 mm (0.20 to 0.39 in.) away from the point
indicated by A.
• The gas is nitrogen, which is colorless, odorless,
and harmless.
BC
BRAKE CONTROL – FRONT SPEED SENSOR
BC–217
FRONT SPEED SENSOR
BRAKE CONTROL
COMPONENTS
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
19 (192, 14)
FRONT SPEED SENSOR
BC
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C127341E01
BC–218
BRAKE CONTROL – FRONT SPEED SENSOR
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
2.
REMOVE FRONT FENDER LINER
3.
REMOVE FRONT SPEED SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the sensor connector.
F046175E01
(b) Remove the 2 bolts (A and B) and 2 sensor clamps
from the body and front shock absorber.
HINT:
The bolt B is tightened together with the brake
flexible hose clamp.
A
B
F046179E02
(c) Remove the clip from the front shock absorber.
(d) Remove the bolt and sensor.
NOTICE:
Do not allow foreign matter to attach to the tip or
connecting portion of the speed sensor.
Clip
F047471E01
BC
BRAKE CONTROL – FRONT SPEED SENSOR
BC–219
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL FRONT SPEED SENSOR
NOTICE:
• Do not twist the sensor wire harness during
installation.
• Check that there is no foreign matter attached to
the tip and connecting portion of the speed
sensor.
(a) Clean the connecting portion of the sensor.
(b) Install the sensor with the bolt.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
(c) Install the clip to the front shock absorber.
Clip
F047471E01
(d) Install the sensor clamps to the body and front
shock absorber with the bolts A and B.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf) for bolt A
19 N*m (192 kgf*cm, 14 ft.*lbf) for bolt B
NOTICE:
Tighten the bolt B together with the brake
flexible hose clamp and sensor clamp. The
brake flexible hose clamp should be placed
above.
A
B
F046179E02
(e) Connect the sensor connector.
2.
INSTALL FRONT FENDER LINER
3.
INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
Torque: 103 N*m (1,050 kgf*cm, 76 ft.*lbf)
4.
CHECK ABS SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL
(a) Check the speed sensor signal (see page BC-23).
F046175E01
BC
BC–220
BRAKE CONTROL – SKID CONTROL SENSOR
SKID CONTROL SENSOR
BRAKE CONTROL
COMPONENTS
SKID CONTROL SENSOR WIRE
61 (622, 45)
61 (622, 45)
SKID CONTROL SENSOR
REAR AXLE HUB AND
BEARING ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
REAR BRAKE DRUM
SUB-ASSEMBLY
Non-reusable part
C127342E01
BC
BRAKE CONTROL – SKID CONTROL SENSOR
BC–221
REMOVAL
Speed Sensor’s
Detecting Portion
SST
Rotor
1.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
2.
REMOVE REAR BRAKE DRUM SUB-ASSEMBLY (See
page BR-47)
3.
SEPARATE SKID CONTROL SENSOR WIRE
4.
REMOVE REAR AXLE HUB AND BEARING
ASSEMBLY (See page AH-10)
5.
REMOVE SKID CONTROL SENSOR
(a) Install the 4 hub nuts to the 4 rear axle hub bolts.
Placing an aluminum plate below the rear axle hub
and bearing, place them into the vise.
NOTICE:
Replace the rear axle hub and bearing if it is
dropped or receives a strong shock.
(b) Using a pin punch (3 mm) or hammer, remove the 2
pins from SST (09520-00031) and separate the
attachment (09521-00010).
(c) Using SST and 2 bolts (90101-12007), remove the
sensor from the rear axle hub and bearing.
SST 09520-00031 (09520-00040), 09521-00020,
09950-00020
NOTICE:
• Pull the sensor off straight, being careful not
to make contact with the sensor rotor.
• If the sensor rotor is damaged or deformed,
replace the rear axle hub and bearing.
• Do not scratch the area where the sensor
contacts the rear axle hub and bearing.
• Do not allow foreign matter to attach to the
sensor rotor.
Bolt
SST
F008657E04
BC
BC–222
BRAKE CONTROL – SKID CONTROL SENSOR
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL SKID CONTROL SENSOR
(a) Wipe off sealant attached to the sensor's fitting
surface with white gasoline.
NOTICE:
Prevent foreign matter from attaching to the
sensor rotor.
(b) Install a new sensor to the rear axle hub and
bearing. The sensor connector should be placed in
the lowest position.
HINT:
The narrow side of the rear axle hub and bearing
should be placed below.
Upper
Lower
F007318E02
(c) Using SST and a press, press the speed sensor so
that it becomes flush with the rear axle hub and
bearing.
SST 09214-76011
NOTICE:
• Do not use a hammer on the sensor.
• Check that there is no foreign matter such as
iron chips on the sensor's detecting portion.
• Slowly press the sensor in straight.
SST
Speed Sensor’s Detecting Portion
F008658E04
BC
2.
INSTALL REAR AXLE HUB AND BEARING
ASSEMBLY (See page AH-11)
3.
INSTALL SKID CONTROL SENSOR WIRE
4.
INSTALL REAR BRAKE DRUM SUB-ASSEMBLY (See
page BR-53)
5.
INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 103 N*m (1,050 kgf*cm, 76 ft.*lbf)
6.
INSPECT REAR WHEEL ALIGNMENT
(a) Inspect the rear wheel alignment (see page SP-10).
7.
CHECK ABS SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL
(a) Check the speed sensor signal (see page BC-23).
BC–223
BRAKE CONTROL – YAW RATE AND DECELERATION SENSOR
YAW RATE AND DECELERATION SENSOR
BRAKE CONTROL
COMPONENTS
CONSOLE BOX POCKET
CONSOLE BOX CARPET
UPPER CONSOLE PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
REAR CONSOLE BOX SUB-ASSEMBLY
19 (194, 14)
BC
YAW RATE SENSOR
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C127952E01
BC–224
BRAKE CONTROL – YAW RATE AND DECELERATION SENSOR
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE UPPER CONSOLE PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
(See page IP-24)
2.
REMOVE CONSOLE BOX POCKET
3.
REMOVE CONSOLE BOX CARPET
4.
REMOVE REAR CONSOLE BOX SUB-ASSEMBLY
(See page IP-24)
5.
REMOVE YAW RATE SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the connector and remove the 2 bolts
and sensor.
F046182E01
INSTALLATION
F046182E01
BC
1.
INSTALL YAW RATE SENSOR
(a) Install the sensor with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 19 N*m (194 kgf*cm, 14 ft.*lbf)
(b) Connect the sensor connector.
2.
INSTALL REAR CONSOLE BOX SUB-ASSEMBLY
(See page IP-25)
3.
INSTALL CONSOLE BOX CARPET
4.
INSTALL CONSOLE BOX POCKET
5.
INSTALL UPPER CONSOLE PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
(See page IP-26)
6.
PERFORM YAW RATE SENSOR ZERO POINT
CALIBRATION
(a) Perform the yaw rate sensor zero point calibration
(see page BC-21).
7.
CHECK AND CLEAR DTC
(a) Check and clear the DTC (see page BC-38).
BC–225
BRAKE CONTROL – STEERING ANGLE SENSOR
STEERING ANGLE SENSOR
BRAKE CONTROL
COMPONENTS
8.8 (90, 78 in.*lbf)
STEERING WHEEL ASSEMBLY
STEERING COLUMN
COVER (UPPER)
50 (510, 37)
SPIRAL CABLE
SUB-ASSEMBLY
NO. 2 STEERING WHEEL
COVER LOWER
STEERING ANGLE
SENSOR
NO. 3 STEERING WHEEL
COVER LOWER
BC
STEERING COLUMN
COVER (LOWER)
TILT LEVER BRACKET
STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C127953E01
BC–226
BRAKE CONTROL – STEERING ANGLE SENSOR
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE NO. 2 STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER
3.
REMOVE NO. 3 STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER
4.
REMOVE STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY (See page RS268)
5.
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL ASSEMBLY (See page
SR-8)
6.
REMOVE TILT LEVER BRACKET (See page SR-8)
7.
REMOVE STEERING COLUMN COVER (See page
SR-8)
8.
REMOVE SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page
RS-278)
9.
REMOVE STEERING ANGLE SENSOR
(a) Detach the 6 claws and remove the sensor from the
spiral cable.
F045898E03
INSTALLATION
BC
1.
INSTALL STEERING ANGLE SENSOR
(a) Align the locating pins, attach the 6 claws and install
the sensor to the spiral cable.
2.
INSPECT SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page
RS-278)
3.
INSTALL SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page
RS-278)
4.
INSTALL STEERING COLUMN COVER (See page SR14)
5.
POSITION SPIRAL CABLE (See page RS-279)
6.
INSTALL TILT LEVER BRACKET (See page SR-14)
7.
INSPECT STEERING WHEEL CENTER POINT (See
page SR-15)
8.
INSTALL STEERING WHEEL ASSEMBLY (See page
SR-15)
F045898E03
BRAKE CONTROL – STEERING ANGLE SENSOR
9.
BC–227
INSTALL STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY (See page RS269)
10. INSPECT STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY
(a) Inspect the steering pad (see page RS-267).
11. CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
12. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
13. CHECK SRS WARNING LIGHT
(a) Check the SRS warning light (see page RS-41).
BC
BC–228
BRAKE CONTROL – SKID CONTROL ECU
SKID CONTROL ECU
BRAKE CONTROL
COMPONENTS
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
SKID CONTROL ECU
BC
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C127345E01
BRAKE CONTROL – SKID CONTROL ECU
BC–229
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the steering column (see page SR-7).
HINT:
Refer to the procedures from the removal of the No
2. rear floor board up until the removal of the
steering column assembly.
3.
REMOVE SKID CONTROL ECU
(a) Remove the wire harness clamp and skid control
buzzer from the skid control ECU bracket.
(b) Disconnect the 4 skid control ECU connectors.
(c) Remove the 3 nuts and skid control ECU.
C127949
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL SKID CONTROL ECU
(a) Install the skid control ECU with the 3 nuts.
Torque: 5.0 N*m (51 kgf*cm, 44 in.*lbf)
(b) Connect the 4 skid control ECU connectors.
(c) Install the wire harness clamp and skid control
buzzer to the skid control ECU bracket.
2.
INSTALL STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the steering column (see page SR-12).
HINT:
Refer to the procedures from the installation of the
steering column assembly up until the installation of
the No 2. rear floor board.
3.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
4.
INSPECT SRS WARNING LIGHT (See page RS-269)
5.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
C127949
BC
BC–230
BC
BRAKE CONTROL – SKID CONTROL ECU
6.
PERFORM SYSTEM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform the brake system initialization (see page
BC-19).
7.
PERFORM YAW RATE SENSOR ZERO POINT
CALIBRATION
(a) Perform the yaw rate sensor zero point calibration
(see page BC-21).
8.
CHECK AND CLEAR DTC
(a) Check and clear the DTCs (see page BC-38).
BC–231
BRAKE CONTROL – BRAKE CONTROL POWER SUPPLY
BRAKE CONTROL POWER SUPPLY
BRAKE CONTROL
COMPONENTS
REAR SEAT CUSHION
ASSEMBLY
DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY RH
NO. 3 BRAKE CONTROL
POWER SUPPLY BRACKET
NO. 1 BRAKE
CONTROL POWER
SUPPLY BRACKET
19 (194, 14)
19 (194, 14)
19 (194, 14)
BRAKE CONTROL POWER
SUPPLY ASSEMBLY
NO. 2 BRAKE CONTROL
POWER SUPPLY BRACKET
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C127950E01
BC
BC–232
BRAKE CONTROL – BRAKE CONTROL POWER SUPPLY
REMOVAL
C127951
BC
1.
REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY (See
page SE-15)
2.
REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Remove the deck trim side panel RH (see page IR7).
HINT:
Refer to the procedures from the removal of the rear
door scuff plate RH up until the removal of the deck
trim side panel assembly RH.
3.
REMOVE BRAKE CONTROL POWER SUPPLY
ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the 4 bolts and brake control power supply.
4.
REMOVE NO. 3 BRAKE CONTROL POWER SUPPLY
BRACKET
5.
REMOVE NO. 2 BRAKE CONTROL POWER SUPPLY
BRACKET
6.
REMOVE NO. 1 BRAKE CONTROL POWER SUPPLY
BRACKET
BRAKE CONTROL – BRAKE CONTROL POWER SUPPLY
BC–233
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL NO. 1 BRAKE CONTROL POWER SUPPLY
BRACKET
2.
INSTALL NO. 2 BRAKE CONTROL POWER SUPPLY
BRACKET
3.
INSTALL NO. 3 BRAKE CONTROL POWER SUPPLY
BRACKET
4.
INSTALL BRAKE CONTROL POWER SUPPLY
ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the brake control power supply with the 4
bolts.
Torque: 19 N*m (194 kgf*cm, 14 ft.*lbf)
(b) Connect the brake control power supply connector.
5.
INSTALL DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Install the deck trim side panel RH (see page IR-13).
HINT:
Refer to the procedures from the installation of the
deck trim side panel assembly RH up until the
installation of the rear door scuff plate RH.
6.
INSTALL REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY (See
page SE-23)
7.
CHECK AND CLEAR DTC
(a) Check and clear the DTC (see page BC-38).
C127951
BC
BC–233
BRAKE CONTROL – BRAKE PEDAL STROKE SENSOR
BRAKE PEDAL STROKE SENSOR
BRAKE CONTROL
COMPONENTS
NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL
REGISTER ASSEMBLY
LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL
FINISH PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
BRAKE PEDAL
SUPPORT
9.3 (95, 82 in.*lbf)
BRAKE PEDAL STROKE
SENSOR ASSEMBLY
BC
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C127343E01
BC–234
BRAKE CONTROL – BRAKE PEDAL STROKE SENSOR
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-5)
2.
REMOVE LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page IP-6)
3.
REMOVE BRAKE PEDAL STROKE SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the sensor connector.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and sensor.
F046144E01
INSTALLATION
1.
F046144E01
BC
F046144E01
INSTALL BRAKE PEDAL STROKE SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
(a) When installing a new brake pedal stroke sensor:
(1) Install the sensor to the brake pedal support
with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 9.3 N*m (95 kgf*cm, 82 in.*lbf)
NOTICE:
• Engage the sensor lever with the brake
pedal groove.
• Check that there is no foreign matter
attached to the sensor's contacting
surface.
(2) Strongly depress the brake pedal and break the
sensor lever set pin.
(3) Remove the broken sensor lever set pin.
(4) Connect the sensor connector.
(b) When reusing the brake pedal stroke sensor:
(1) Temporarily install the sensor to the brake
pedal support with the 2 bolts.
NOTICE:
• Engage the sensor lever with the brake
pedal groove.
• Check that there is no foreign matter
attached to the sensor's contacting
surface.
(2) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(3) Connect the sensor connector.
BRAKE CONTROL – BRAKE PEDAL STROKE SENSOR
BC–235
(4) Turn the power switch ON (IG). Reading the
stroke sensor 1 value, turn the sensor slowly to
the right and left to adjust it to the standard
value.
Standard voltage:
0.8 to 1.2 V
F046139E01
(5) Tighten the 2 bolts.
Torque: 9.3 N*m (95 kgf*cm, 82 in.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Do not depress the brake pedal after turning
the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Carry out system initialization (see page BC-19).
F046144E01
2.
INSTALL LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page IP-13)
3.
INSTALL NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-13)
BC
BRAKE – BRAKE SYSTEM
BR–1
BRAKE SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
NOTICE:
• Care must be taken to replace each part properly as it
could affect the performance of the brake system and
result in a driving hazard. Replace the parts with parts
having the same part number or equivalent parts.
• It is very important to keep parts and the area clean
when repairing the brake system.
• When air remains in the brake line or disconnecting
the brake line, bleed the air.
• Wash brake fluid off immediately if it adheres to any
painted surface.
• Prevent brake fluid from adhering to electronic parts.
• If the vehicle is equipped with a mobile
communication system, refer to the precaution in the
INTRODUCTION section (see page IN-5).
• When disconnecting the negative (-) battery terminal,
initialize the following system after the terminal is
reconnected.
System Name
See procedure
Power Window Control System
IN-32
BR
BR–2
BRAKE – BRAKE SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
Use the table below to help determine the cause of the
problem symptom. The potential causes of the symptoms are
listed in order of probability in the "Suspected area" column of
the table. Check each symptom by checking the suspected
areas in the order they are listed. Replace parts as
necessary.
Brake system
Symptom
Low pedal or spongy pedal
Brake drag
Brake pull
Hard pedal but brake inefficient
BR
Noise from brake
Suspected area
See page
1. Fluid leaks for brake system
-
2. Air in brake system
BR-3
3. Front brake piston seals (Worn or damaged)
BR-41
4. Rear brake wheel cylinder cups (Worn or damaged)
BR-47
5. Master cylinder (Faulty)
BR-27
6. Push rod (Out of adjustment)
BR-22
7. Stroke simulator cylinder (Faulty)
BR-35
1. Brake pedal free play (Minimal)
BR-23
2. Parking brake pedal travel (Out of adjustment)
PB-1
3. Parking brake cable (Sticking)
PB-14
4. Rear brake shoe clearance (Out of adjustment)
BR-53
5. Front brake pad (Cracked or distorted)
BR-40
6. Rear brake lining (Cracked or distorted)
BR-47
7. Front brake piston (Stuck or frozen)
BR-41
8. Rear brake wheel cylinder piston (Stuck or frozen)
BR-47
9. Tension or return spring (Faulty)
BR-47
10. Push rod (Out of adjustment)
BR-22
11. Master cylinder (Faulty)
BR-27
1. Front brake piston (Stuck)
BR-41
2. Rear brake wheel cylinder piston (Stuck)
BR-47
3. Front brake pad (Oily, cracked or distorted)
BR-40
4. Rear brake lining (Oily, cracked or distorted)
BR-47
5. Front brake piston (Frozen)
BR-41
6. Rear brake wheel cylinder piston (Frozen)
BR-47
7. Disc (Scored)
BR-41
1. Brake pedal (Out of adjustment, faulty)
BR-22
2. Front brake piston (Frozen)
BR-41
3. Rear brake wheel cylinder piston (Frozen)
BR-47
4. Front brake pad (Cracked, distorted, glazed or oily)
BR-40
5. Rear brake lining (Cracked, distorted, glazed or oily)
BR-47
6. Disc (Oily)
BR-41
7. Push rod (Out of adjustment)
BR-22
1. Front brake pad (Cracked, distorted, dirty or glazed)
BR-40
2. Rear brake lining (Cracked, distorted, dirty or glazed)
BR-47
3. Installation bolt (Loose)
BR-44
4. Disc (Scored)
BR-41
5. Pad support plate (Loose)
BR-41
6. Slide pin (Worn)
BR-40
7. Tension or return spring (Faulty)
BR-47
8. Anti-squeal shim (Damaged)
BR-40
9. Shoe hold-down spring (Damaged)
BR-47
BRAKE – BRAKE FLUID
BR–3
BRAKE FLUID
BLEEDING
CAUTION:
Bleeding without the intelligent tester may result in the
air not being completely bled. As this can result in an
accident, be sure to use the intelligent tester for air
bleeding.
NOTICE:
• Move the shift lever to the P position and apply the
parking brake before bleeding air.
• Add brake fluid carefully so that it remains between
the MIN and MAX lines of the reservoir while bleeding
air.
• Brake fluid may overflow when bleeding the brake
actuator hose. Do not place the fluid can on the
reservoir inlet.
• If the pump motor operates while there is air
remaining inside the brake actuator hose, the air will
enter the actuator, resulting in difficulty of air
bleeding. Remove the No. 1 and No. 2 motor relays
until instructed to reinstall them in order to prevent air
from coming into the brake actuator hose.
• The actuator pump motor and master pressure cut-off
solenoid can operate through a supplemental power
source even if the power switch is OFF.
• A buzzer may sound due to the accumulator pressure
decline during air bleeding. However, continue
bleeding.
• DTCs for problems such as No. 1 and No. 2 motor
relay malfunctions and pressure sensor malfunctions
are stored after bleeding. Clear the DTCs when
instructed during or after bleeding.
• Bleed the brake actuator hose if air enters as a result
of the decline of reservoir fluid.
1.
PREPARE FOR BLEEDING
(a) Move the shift lever to the P position and apply the
parking brake.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3 with the
power switch OFF as shown in the illustration.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and turn on the
intelligent tester.
NOTICE:
Do not start the engine.
(d) Select "DIAGNOSTIC MENU" "ABS/VSC" "AIR
BLEEDING" on the intelligent tester.
Intelligent Tester
DLC3
A082795E05
BR
BR–4
BRAKE – BRAKE FLUID
AIR BLEEDING
1. Usual
2. Actuator
3. Master Cylinder
or Stroke Simulator
Select the work No.
1
2
3
PRESS [ENTER]
F101050E01
(e) Select "AIR BLEEDING".
(1) Select "Usual" if the front/rear brakes were
removed, installed or disassembled.
HINT:
Go to "BLEED AIR FROM FRONT AND REAR
BRAKE SYSTEMS" if "Usual" is selected.
(2) Select "Actuator" if the actuator is removed,
installed or replaced.
NOTICE:
Be sure to release the pressure out of the
actuator before removing. See "BLEED AIR
FROM BRAKE ACTUATOR" for bleeding
instructions.
HINT:
Go to "BLEED AIR FROM BRAKE
ACTUATOR" if "Actuator" is selected.
(3) Select "Master Cylinder or Stroke Simulator" if
the brake master cylinder or the brake stroke
simulator was removed, installed or replaced.
HINT:
Go to "BLEED AIR FROM MASTER
CYLINDER/STROKE SIMULATOR" if "Master
Cylinder or Stroke Simulator" is selected.
(f)
FAILED
This command can
not be available.
PRESS [ENTER]
BR
F101050E04
Return to "MENU" and bleed the air again if the
display (see illustration for reference) appears
during air bleeding.
BRAKE – BRAKE FLUID
BR–5
(g) Remove and install the relays as shown in the
illustration if instructed to remove and install No. 1
and No. 2 motor relays by the intelligent tester.
2.
FILL RESERVOIR WITH BRAKE FLUID
NOTICE:
Wash brake fluid off immediately if it adheres to any
painted surface.
(a) Add brake fluid into the reservoir.
Fluid:
SAE J1703 or FMVSS No. 116 DOT3
3.
BLEED AIR FROM MASTER CYLINDER
HINT:
If the master cylinder has been disassembled or if the
reservoir becomes empty, bleed the air out of the master
cylinder.
(a) Disconnect the brake lines from the master cylinder.
SST 09023-00100
(b) Slowly depress and hold the brake pedal.
F046145E01
F046645E01
(c) Cover the outer holes with your fingers, and release
the brake pedal.
(d) Repeat the above steps 3 or 4 times.
(e) Connect the brake lines to the master cylinder.
SST 09023-00100
Torque: 15 N*m (155 kgf*cm, 11 ft.*lbf)
F046646E01
4.
OPERATION
1. Turn the IG OFF.
2. Remove the motor
relays No. 1 and
No. 2.
3. Turn the IG ON.
PRESS [ENTER]
F101050E05
BLEED AIR FROM FRONT AND REAR BRAKE
SYSTEMS
NOTICE:
Wash brake fluid off immediately if it adheres to any
painted surface.
HINT:
Bleed the air out of the front and rear brake systems in
accordance with the display (see illustration for
reference).
(a) Remove the No. 1 and No. 2 motor relays.
NOTICE:
• Remove the No. 1 and No. 2 motor relays
before bleeding the air out of the front brake
system.
• Be sure to turn the power switch OFF before
removing the No. 1 and No. 2 motor relays.
BR
BR–6
BRAKE – BRAKE FLUID
(b) Bleed the air out of the FR/FL wheels if the display
(see illustration for reference) appears.
(1) Remove the bleeder plug cap.
(2) Connect the vinyl tube to the bleeder plug.
(3) Depress the brake pedal several times, then
loosen the bleeder plug with the brake pedal
depressed.
(4) When the fluid stops coming out, tighten the
bleeder plug, and then release the brake pedal.
Torque: 8.4 N*m (86 kgf*cm, 74 in.*lbf)
(5) Repeat the above steps until all the air in the
fluid is completely bled out.
(6) Install the bleeder plug cap.
(7) Repeat the previous procedures to bleed the
air out of the brake line for each wheel.
OPERATION
Perform the usual
air bleeding for
FR and FL wheels.
PRESS [ENTER]
F101050E06
(c) Install the No. 1 and No. 2 motor relays.
NOTICE:
• Install the No. 1 and No. 2 motor relays before
bleeding the air out of the rear brake system.
• Be sure to turn the power switch OFF before
installing the No. 1 and No. 2 motor relays.
OPERATION
1. Turn the IG OFF.
2. Install the motor
relays No. 1 and
No. 2.
3. Turn the IG ON.
PRESS [ENTER]
F101050E07
BR
BRAKE – BRAKE FLUID
BR–7
(d) Bleed the air out of the RL wheel if the display (see
illustration for reference) appears.
(1) Remove the bleeder plug cap of RL wheel.
(2) Connect the vinyl tube to the bleeder plug of RL
wheel.
(3) Depress the brake pedal and loosen the
bleeder plug of RL wheel until all the air in the
fluid is completely bled out.
NOTICE:
Do not pump the brake pedal. Hold the
brake pedal depressed when bleeding the
air out of the rear brake system.
HINT:
The actuator motor relay starts operation and
oil pressure is applied to the rear brake system
if the brake pedal is depressed, which allows
air bleeding through the bleeder plug.
(4) Tighten the bleeder plug if the air is completely
bled out.
Torque: 8.4 N*m (86 kgf*cm, 74 in.*lbf)
OPERATION
Hold the brake
pedal depressed and
loosen the bleeder
plug of RL wheel
until all the air
in the fluid is
completely bled
out.
PRESS [ENTER]
F101050E08
(e) Bleed the air out of the RR wheel if the display (see
illustration for reference) appears.
(1) Remove the bleeder plug cap of RR wheel.
(2) Connect the vinyl tube to the bleeder plug of
RR wheel.
(3) Depress the brake pedal and loosen the
bleeder plug of RR wheel until all the air in the
fluid is completely bled out.
NOTICE:
Do not pump the brake pedal. Hold the
brake pedal depressed when bleeding the
air out of the rear brake system.
HINT:
The actuator motor relay starts operation and
oil pressure is applied to the rear brake system
if the brake pedal is depressed, which allows
air bleeding through the bleeder plug.
OPERATION
Hold the brake
pedal depressed and
loosen the bleeder
plug of RR wheel
until all the air
in the fluid is
completely bled
out.
PRESS [ENTER]
F101050E09
BR
BR–8
BRAKE – BRAKE FLUID
(f)
The air bleeding of the front and rear brake system
finishes if the display (see illustration for reference)
appears.
Air Bleeding is
COMPLETE.
PRESS [ENTER]
F101050E10
5.
INFORMATION
Do you wish to
refresh the
high pressure line?
This operation
will take
20 seconds.
PRESS [ENTER]
F101050E11
BR
BLEED AIR FROM BRAKE ACTUATOR
NOTICE:
Wash brake fluid off immediately if it adheres to any
painted surface.
HINT:
Bleed the air out of the brake actuator in accordance with
the display (see illustration for reference).
(a) Refresh the high pressure line.
NOTICE:
Be sure to perform this procedure before
replacement, removal or installation of the
actuator.
HINT:
• Decrease the internal pressure by performing
this procedure.
• Count down from 20 seconds.
BRAKE – BRAKE FLUID
BR–9
(b) Follow the procedures shown on the display (see
illustration for reference).
NOTICE:
Be sure to remove the No. 1 and No. 2 motor
relays before removing the actuator for
replacement, removal or installation.
OPERATION
1. Turn the IG OFF.
2. Remove the motor
relays No. 1 and
No. 2.
3. Turn the IG ON.
4. Confirm ABS pump
motor runs and
stops.
PRESS [ENTER]
F101050E02
(c) Follow the procedures shown on the display (see
illustration for reference).
HINT:
See "BLEED AIR FROM FRONT AND REAR
BRAKE SYSTEMS" for bleeding the air out of the
front brake system.
OPERATION
Perform the usual
air bleeding for
FR and FL wheels.
PRESS [ENTER]
F101050E06
BR
BR–10
BRAKE – BRAKE FLUID
(d) Bleed the air out of the drain line.
NOTICE:
Be sure to perform this procedure if air remains
in the actuator hose.
HINT:
Fluid inside the actuator hose returns to the
reservoir tank when performing this procedure.
INFORMATION
Do you wish to
bleed the air out
of the drain line?
This command
activates solenoids
(SLRFR, SLRFL,
SLRRR and SLRRL).
PRESS [ENTER]
F101050E12
(e) Depress the brake pedal 30 times within 30 seconds
while the solenoid is operating.
HINT:
The solenoid stops operation automatically after
approximately 30 seconds.
(f) Install the No. 1 and No. 2 motor relays.
NOTICE:
• Install the No. 1 and No. 2 motor relays before
bleeding the air out of the rear brake system.
• Be sure to turn the power switch OFF before
installing the No. 1 and No. 2 motor relays.
OPERATION
1. Depress the brake
pedal 30 times in
30 seconds.
2. Turn the IG OFF.
3. Install the motor
relays No. 1 and
No. 2.
4. Turn the IG ON.
PRESS [ENTER]
F101050E03
BR
BRAKE – BRAKE FLUID
BR–11
(g) Bleed the air out of the rear brake RL wheel.
HINT:
See "BLEED AIR FROM FRONT AND REAR
BRAKE SYSTEMS" for bleeding the air out of the
rear brake system.
OPERATION
Hold the brake
pedal depressed and
loosen the bleeder
plug of RL wheel
until all the air
in the fluid is
completely bled
out.
PRESS [ENTER]
F101050E08
(h) Bleed the air out of the rear brake RR wheel.
HINT:
See "BLEED AIR FROM FRONT AND REAR
BRAKE SYSTEMS" for bleeding the air out of the
rear brake system.
OPERATION
Hold the brake
pedal depressed and
loosen the bleeder
plug of RR wheel
until all the air
in the fluid is
completely bled
out.
PRESS [ENTER]
F101050E09
BR
BR–12
BRAKE – BRAKE FLUID
(i)
Loosen the bleeder plug of FL wheel.
(j)
Bleed the air out of the power supply line.
HINT:
Air can be bled out of the high pressure line inside
the actuator when performing this procedure.
OPERATION
Loosen the bleeder
plug of FL wheel.
PRESS [ENTER]
F101050E13
INFORMATION
Do you wish to
bleed the air out
of the power
supply line?
This command
activates solenoids
(SMC2 and SLAFL).
PRESS [ENTER]
F101050E21
BR
BRAKE – BRAKE FLUID
BR–13
(k) Tighten the bleeder plug of FL wheel.
Torque: 8.4 N*m (86 kgf*cm, 74 in.*lbf)
OPERATION
Tighten the bleeder
plug of FL wheel.
PRESS [ENTER]
F101050E15
(l)
INFORMATION
(*/2)
Do you wish to
bleed the air out
of the stroke
Bleed the air out of the stroke simulator line.
HINT:
• See "BLEED AIR FROM BRAKE MASTER
CYLINDER/STROKE SIMULATOR" for bleeding
the air out of the stroke simulator.
• Bleed the air out of the stroke simulator twice.
• The number of times air is bled is displayed as 1/
2 (first) and 2/2 (second).
simulator line?
This command
activates solenoids
(SMC2 and SCSS).
PRESS [ENTER]
F101050E22
BR
BR–14
BRAKE – BRAKE FLUID
(1) Depress the brake pedal 20 times in 20
seconds.
HINT:
Depress the brake pedal 20 times at 1 second
intervals, holding the pedal down on the last
depression.
OPERATION
(*/2)
Depress the brake
pedal 20 times in
20 seconds.
PRESS [ENTER]
F101050E17
(2) Perform the usual air bleeding for the FL wheel.
HINT:
• Loosen the bleeder plug of the FL wheel and
bleed the air with the brake pedal
depressed.
• See "BLEED AIR FROM FRONT AND
REAR BRAKE SYSTEMS" for bleeding
instructions.
OPERATION
(*/2)
Perform the usual
air bleeding for
FL wheel.
PRESS [ENTER]
F101050E18
BR
BRAKE – BRAKE FLUID
BR–15
(m) Refresh the high pressure line.
NOTICE:
Keep the fluid inside the reservoir above the
"LOW" level by replenishing fluid.
HINT:
• Accumulator pressure is released and
accumulated repeatedly, which circulates the
fluid inside the accumulator when performing this
procedure.
• The high pressure line is refreshed 5 times. The
number of times refreshed is displayed as 1/5
(first), 2/5 (second), etc.
• Count down from 20 seconds.
INFORMATION
(*/5)
Do you wish to
refresh the
high pressure line?
This operation
will take
20 seconds.
PRESS [ENTER]
F101050E19
(n) Turn the power switch OFF. Turn the power switch
ON (IG) and check if the ABS motor pump runs and
stops.
HINT:
The pump motor rotates and the accumulator is
pressurized every time the power switch is turned
from OFF to ON (IG).
(o) Return to "MENU".
OPERATION
(*/5)
1. Turn the IG OFF,
and ON again.
2. Confirm the ABS
motor pump runs and
stops.
PRESS [ENTER]
F101050E23
BR
BR–16
BRAKE – BRAKE FLUID
6.
OPERATION
1. Turn the IG OFF.
2. Remove the motor
relays No. 1 and
No. 2.
3. Turn the IG ON.
BLEED AIR FROM MASTER CYLINDER/STROKE
SIMULATOR
NOTICE:
Wash brake fluid off immediately if it adheres to any
painted surface.
HINT:
Bleed the air out of the master cylinder/stroke simulator
in accordance with the display (see illustration for
reference).
(a) Remove the No. 1 and No. 2 motor relays.
NOTICE:
• Remove the No. 1 and No. 2 motor relays
before bleeding the air out of the front brake
system.
• Be sure to turn the power switch OFF before
removing the No. 1 and No. 2 motor relays.
PRESS [ENTER]
F101050E05
(b) Bleed the air out of the FR/FL wheels in accordance
with the display (see illustration for reference).
HINT:
• Air can be completely bled out of the master
cylinder by performing this procedure.
• See "BLEED AIR FROM FRONT AND REAR
BRAKE SYSTEMS" for bleeding instructions.
OPERATION
Perform the usual
air bleeding for
FR and FL wheels.
PRESS [ENTER]
F101050E06
BR
BRAKE – BRAKE FLUID
BR–17
(c) Install the No. 1 and No. 2 motor relays.
NOTICE:
• Install the No. 1 and No. 2 motor relays before
bleeding the air out of the stroke simulator.
• Be sure to turn the power switch OFF before
installing the No. 1 and No. 2 motor relays.
OPERATION
1. Turn the IG OFF.
2. Install the motor
relays No. 1 and
No. 2.
3. Turn the IG ON.
PRESS [ENTER]
F101050E07
(d) Bleed the air out of the stroke simulator line.
HINT:
• Bleed the air out of the stroke simulator twice.
• The number of times air is bled is displayed as 1/
2 (first) and 2/2 (second).
INFORMATION
(*/2)
Do you wish to
bleed the air out
of the stroke
simulator line?
This command
activates solenoids
(SMC2 and SCSS).
PRESS [ENTER]
F101050E24
BR
BR–18
BRAKE – BRAKE FLUID
(1) Depress the brake pedal 20 times in 20
seconds.
HINT:
Depress the brake pedal 20 times at 1 second
intervals, holding the brake pedal down on the
last depression.
OPERATION
(*/2)
Depress the brake
pedal 20 times in
20 seconds.
PRESS [ENTER]
F101050E17
(2) Perform the usual air bleeding for the FL wheel.
HINT:
• Loosen the bleeder plug of the FL wheel and
bleed the air with the brake pedal
depressed.
• See "BLEED AIR FROM FRONT AND
REAR BRAKE SYSTEMS" for bleeding
instructions.
OPERATION
(*/2)
Perform the usual
air bleeding for
FL wheel.
PRESS [ENTER]
F101050E18
BR
BRAKE – BRAKE FLUID
BR–19
(e) The air bleeding of the master cylinder/stroke
simulator finishes if the display (see illustration for
reference) appears.
7.
CHECK AND CLEAR DTC
(a) Check and clear the DTC (see page BC-38).
Air Bleeding is
COMPLETE.
PRESS [ENTER]
F101050E10
BR
BR–20
BRAKE – BRAKE PEDAL
BRAKE PEDAL
BRAKE
COMPONENTS
BRAKE PEDAL SUPPORT
SUB-ASSEMBLY
24 (241, 18)
BRAKE PEDAL STROKE
SENSOR ASSEMBLY
STOP LIGHT
SWITCH ASSEMBLY
9.3 (95, 82 in.*lbf)
13 (130, 9)
BRAKE PEDAL BUSH
BRAKE PEDAL BUSH
BRAKE PEDAL SHAFT COLLAR
BRAKE PEDAL SHAFT
BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER
PUSH ROD CLEVIS
37 (375, 27)
CLIP
BRAKE PEDAL
RETURN SPRING
BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER
PUSH ROD PIN
BRAKE PEDAL SUB-ASSEMBLY
BR
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
BRAKE PEDAL PAD
Lithium soap base glycol grease
C130367E02
BRAKE – BRAKE PEDAL
BR–21
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the instrument panel (see page IP-5).
HINT:
Refer to the procedures from the removal of the No.
1 instrument panel register assembly up until the
removal of the instrument panel sub-assembly.
3.
REMOVE MASTER CYLINDER PUSH ROD CLEVIS
(a) Remove the brake pedal return spring.
(b) Remove the clip and brake master cylinder push rod
pin.
(c) Separate the push rod clevis from the brake pedal.
4.
REMOVE BRAKE PEDAL SUPPORT SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connector from the stop light switch.
(b) Disconnect the connector from the brake pedal
stroke sensor.
(c) Remove the bolt from the instrument panel upper
panel side.
F046140E01
F046141E01
(d) Remove the 4 nuts and the brake pedal support.
BR
F046142E01
BR–22
BRAKE – BRAKE PEDAL
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE BRAKE PEDAL PAD
2.
REMOVE STOP LIGHT SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Loosen the stop light switch lock nut and remove
the stop light switch from the brake pedal support.
3.
REMOVE BRAKE PEDAL STROKE SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and brake pedal stroke sensor
from the brake pedal support.
4.
REMOVE BRAKE PEDAL SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the nut from the brake pedal shaft.
(b) Remove the brake pedal shaft and separate the
brake pedal from the brake pedal support.
(c) Remove the 2 brake pedal bushes from the brake
pedal.
(d) Remove the brake pedal shaft collar from the brake
pedal shaft.
F046143E01
F046144E01
ADJUSTMENT
Push Rod
Lock Nut
Stop Light
Switch
Clevis
Lock Nut
BR
Pedal Height
G031997E01
1.
CHECK AND ADJUST BRAKE PEDAL HEIGHT
NOTICE:
Pull up the floor carpet and dash panel insulator, and
then check and adjust the brake pedal height.
(a) Remove the lower instrument panel finish panel
(see page IP-6).
(b) Inspect brake pedal height.
Pedal height from the top of the asphalt sheet:
138 to 148 mm (5.433 to 5.827 in.)
(c) Adjust brake pedal height.
(1) Disconnect the connector from the stop light
switch.
(2) Loosen the stop light switch lock nut. Turn the
switch in order to give the pedal some free play.
(3) Loosen the clevis lock nut. Turn the push rod
and adjust the pedal height.
(4) Tighten the clevis lock nut.
Torque: 26 N*m (265 kgf*cm, 19 ft.*lbf)
BRAKE – BRAKE PEDAL
BR–23
(5) Turn the stop light switch so that the clearance
between its thread portion tip and the area
where the pedal makes contact is between 0.5
to 2.4 mm (0.020 to 0.095 in.). Tighten the lock
nut.
Torque: 26 N*m (265 kgf*cm, 19 ft.*lbf)
(6) Connect the connector to the stop light switch.
(7) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(8) Loosen the stroke sensor set bolts.
Lock Nut
0.5 to 2.4 mm
F101053E01
(9) Turn the power switch ON (IG). Read the
stroke sensor 1 value displayed on the data
monitor using the intelligent tester. Slowly turn
the stroke sensor to the right and left to adjust it
to the standard value.
Standard voltage:
0.8 to 1.2 V
(10) Tighten the stroke sensor set bolts.
Torque: 9.3 N*m (95 kgf*cm, 82 in.*lbf)
CAUTION:
Do not depress the brake pedal after the
power switch turns ON (IG).
(11) Carry out system initialization (see page BC19).
(d) Install lower instrument panel finish panel (see page
IP-13).
F046139E01
2.
Pedal
Free Play
G032000E01
CHECK BRAKE PEDAL FREE PLAY
(a) Depress the brake pedal several times strongly after
the engine stops.
(b) Check the brake pedal free play.
Standard pedal free play:
0.5 to 4 mm (0.02 to 0.16 in.)
If incorrect, proceed to the following step.
(1) Check the stop light switch clearance.
Standard stop light switch clearance:
0.5 to 2.4 mm (0.020 to 0.095 in.)
If the clearance is OK, then troubleshoot the
brake system.
If incorrect, adjust the stop light switch
clearance.
BR
BR–24
BRAKE – BRAKE PEDAL
3.
Pedal Reserve
Distance
F101054E01
BR
CHECK BRAKE PEDAL RESERVE DISTANCE
(a) Release the parking brake pedal.
(b) With engine running, depress the pedal and
measure the pedal reserve distance, as shown in
the illustration.
Standard pedal reserve distance (from the top of
the asphalt sheet):
196 N (20 kgf, 44.1 lbf): More than 104 mm (4.1
in.)
NOTICE:
Pull up the floor carpet and dash panel insulator,
and then check the brake pedal reserve
distance.
If incorrect, troubleshoot the brake system.
BRAKE – BRAKE PEDAL
BR–25
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL BRAKE PEDAL SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Apply lithium soap base glycol grease to 2 new
brake pedal bushes. Install the brake pedal bushes
to the brake pedal.
(b) Install the brake pedal shaft collar to the brake pedal
shaft.
(c) Install the brake pedal to the brake pedal support
with the brake pedal shaft and nut.
Torque: 37 N*m (375 kgf*cm, 27 ft.*lbf)
2.
INSTALL BRAKE PEDAL STROKE SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the brake pedal stroke sensor to the brake
pedal support with the 2 bolts.
HINT:
Tighten the bolts when checking and adjusting the
brake pedal height.
3.
INSTALL STOP LIGHT SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Turn the stop light switch clockwise and install it to
the brake pedal support.
HINT:
Tighten the lock nut when checking and adjusting
the brake pedal height.
4.
INSTALL BRAKE PEDAL PAD
F046144E01
F046143
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL BRAKE PEDAL SUPPORT SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the brake pedal support with the 4 nuts.
Torque: 13 N*m (130 kgf*cm, 9 ft.*lbf)
F046142E01
(b) Install the brake pedal support to the instrument
panel side with the bolt.
Torque: 24 N*m (241 kgf*cm, 18 ft.*lbf)
(c) Connect the connector to the stop light switch.
(d) Connect the connector to the brake pedal stroke
sensor.
F046141E01
BR
BR–26
BRAKE – BRAKE PEDAL
2.
INSTALL MASTER CYLINDER PUSH ROD CLEVIS
(a) Apply lithium soap base glycol grease to the
circumference of the brake master cylinder push rod
pin.
(b) Install the push rod clevis to the brake pedal with the
brake master cylinder push rod pin.
(c) Install the clip and brake pedal return spring.
3.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the instrument panel (see page IP-11).
HINT:
Refer to the procedures from the installation of the
instrument panel sub-assembly up until the
installation of the No 1. instrument panel register
assembly.
4.
CHECK AND ADJUST BRAKE PEDAL HEIGHT (See
page BR-22)
5.
CHECK BRAKE PEDAL FREE PLAY (See page BR23)
6.
CHECK BRAKE PEDAL RESERVE DISTANCE (See
page BR-24)
7.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
8.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
F046140E01
BR
BR–26
BRAKE – BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER
BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER
BRAKE
COMPONENTS
6.4 (65, 57 in.*lbf)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
x7
Non-reusable part
Lithium soap base glycol grease
OUTER FRONT COWL TOP
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
ENGINE ROOM
NO. 2 R/B
8.4 (86, 74 in.*lbf)
RESERVOIR
TUBE HOSE
RESERVOIR TUBE
INVERTER WITH
CONVERTER
CLIP
CLIP
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
NO. 1 FRONT BRAKE TUBE
15 (155, 11)
CLIP
BRACKET
15 (155, 11)
15 (155, 11)
NO. 1 BRAKE MASTER
CYLINDER UNION
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
15 (155, 11)
1.8 (18, 16 in.*lbf)
BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER
SUB-ASSEMBLY
NO. 2 FRONT
BRAKE TUBE
NO. 5 FRONT
BRAKE TUBE
GROMMET
SCREW
BR
GASKET
2-WAY
BRAKE TUBE
CLIP
BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER
PUSH ROD CLEVIS
15 (155, 11)
13 (127, 9)
BRAKE MASTER
CYLINDER PUSH
ROD PIN
13 (127, 9) 26 (265, 19)
15 (155, 11)
CLEVIS LOCK NUT
C130368E01
BR–27
BRAKE – BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
NOTICE:
The DTC may be stored after inspection. Be sure to clear
the DTC and check that a normal system code is output
after the inspection is finished.
1.
INSPECT BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER
(a) Check battery voltage.
Standard battery voltage:
10 to 14 V (during engine stop)
(b) Connect intelligent tester and pedal effort gauge.
(1) Connect the pedal effort gauge.
(2) Move the shift lever to the P position. Apply the
parking brake and connect the intelligent tester
to the DLC3.
(3) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(4) Clear the DTC (see page BC-38).
(c) Check operation w/o brake booster.
(1) Check and adjust brake pedal height (see page
BR-22).
(2) Check pedal free play (see page BR-23).
(3) Check pedal reserve distance (see page BR24).
(4) Turn on the intelligent tester and select "ECB
INVALID" to prohibit the brake control (ECB).
(5) Monitor "MAS CYL PRS 1", "MAS CYL PRS 2",
"PEDAL STROKE" and "PEDAL STROKE 2"
using the intelligent tester.
(6) Check the value output from "MAS CYL PRS
1", "MAS CYL PRS 2", "PEDAL STROKE" and
"PEDAL STROKE 2" by depressing the brake
pedal.
Standard output voltage
Pedal Effort
N (kgf, lbf)
MAS CYL PRS 1
(V)
MAS CYL PRS 2
(V)
PEDAL STROKE
(V)
PEDAL STROKE 2
(V)
200 (20.4, 45)
0.9 to 1.2
0.9 to 1.2
1.7 to 2.1
2.9 to 3.3
500 (51, 112)
1.7 to 2.2
1.7 to 2.2
1.9 to 2.3
2.7 to 3.1
(7) Finish the brake control prohibition on the
intelligent tester.
BR
BR–28
BRAKE – BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR AND LINK
ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the windshield wiper motor and link (see
page WW-13).
HINT:
Refer to the procedures from the removal of the
front wiper arm LH/RH up until the removal of the
windshield wiper motor and link assembly.
2.
SET BRAKE CONTROL (ECB) OFF
NOTICE:
Prohibit the brake control (ECB) before bleeding the
brake fluid.
(a) With the power switch OFF to prohibit brake control,
remove the No. 1 and No. 2 motor relays.
NOTICE:
If the pump motor operates while there is air
remaining inside the brake actuator hose, the air
will enter the actuator, resulting in difficulty in
air bleeding.
HINT:
Brake control (ECB) can be prohibited by selecting
"ECB INVALID" on the intelligent tester.
3.
REMOVE OUTER FRONT COWL TOP PANEL SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and engine room No. 2 R/B.
F046145E01
F046090E01
(b) Remove the 3 clamps from the outer front cowl top
panel.
BR
F046146E01
BRAKE – BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER
BR–29
(c) Remove the 7 bolts and outer front cowl top panel.
F046147E01
4.
REMOVE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
(a) Remove the inverter with converter (see page HV530).
HINT:
Refer to the procedures from the removal of the
engine under cover LH up until the removal of the
inverter with converter.
5.
DRAIN BRAKE FLUID
NOTICE:
Wash brake fluid off immediately if it adheres to any
painted surface.
6.
REMOVE NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-5)
7.
REMOVE LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page IP-6)
8.
REMOVE BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the brake return spring.
(b) Remove the clip and brake master cylinder push rod
pin, and disconnect the push rod clevis from the
brake pedal.
F046148E01
(c) Remove the 4 clips and 2 reservoir tube hoses.
F046149E01
(d) Remove the bolt from the actuator bracket.
(e) Using SST, remove the No. 1 front brake tube.
SST 09023-00101
Bolt
BR
F046150E01
BR–30
BRAKE – BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER
(f)
Using SST, disconnect the No. 2 front brake tube
from the clamp and brake master cylinder.
SST 09023-00101
F046151E01
(g) Remove the 2 nuts, brake master cylinder gasket
and brake master cylinder from the bracket.
F046152E01
(h) Using SST, remove the brake tube and 2-way from
the brake master cylinder.
SST 09023-00101
F046154E01
(i)
Remove the screw, No. 1 brake master cylinder
union and 2 grommets from the brake master
cylinder.
(j)
Loosen the clevis lock nut and remove the brake
master cylinder push rod clevis.
F101067
BR
F101055
BRAKE – BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER
BR–31
INSTALLATION
1.
Lithium Soap Base Glycol Grease
INSTALL BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Install the brake master cylinder push rod clevis to
the brake master cylinder, and tighten the lock nut.
HINT:
After adjusting the brake pedal height, torque the
lock nut.
(b) Apply lithium soap base glycol grease to 2 new
grommets.
(c) Install the No. 1 brake master cylinder union and 2
grommets to the brake master cylinder with the
screw.
Torque: 1.8 N*m (18 kgf*cm, 16 in.*lbf)
F101067E02
(d) Using SST, install the brake tube and 2-way to the
brake master cylinder.
SST 09023-00101
Torque: 15 N*m (155 kgf*cm, 11 ft.*lbf)
F101066
(e) Placing the gasket inbetween, install the brake
master cylinder to the bracket with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 13 N*m (127 kgf*cm, 9 ft.*lbf)
F046152E01
(f)
Using SST, connect the No. 2 front brake tube to the
clamp and brake master cylinder.
SST 09023-00101
Torque: 15 N*m (155 kgf*cm, 11 ft.*lbf)
BR
F046151E01
BR–32
BRAKE – BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER
(g) Using SST, install the No. 1 front brake tube.
SST 09023-00101
Torque: 15 N*m (155 kgf*cm, 11 ft.*lbf)
(h) Install the bolt to the actuator bracket.
Torque: 5.0 N*m (51 kgf*cm, 44 in.*lbf)
Bolt
F046150E01
(i)
Install the 2 reservoir tube hoses and hold them
there with the 4 clips.
F046149E01
(j)
Connect the push rod clevis to the brake pedal with
the brake master cylinder push rod pin.
(k) Install the clip and brake pedal return spring.
2.
INSTALL INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
(a) Install the inverter with converter (see page HV535).
HINT:
Refer to the procedures from the installation of the
inverter with converter up until the installation of the
engine under cover LH.
3.
INSTALL OUTER FRONT COWL TOP PANEL SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Install the outer front cowl top panel with the 7 bolts.
Torque: 6.4 N*m (65 kgf*cm, 57 in.*lbf)
F046148E01
F046147E01
(b) Install the 3 clamps to the outer front cowl top panel.
BR
F046146E01
BRAKE – BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER
BR–33
(c) Install the engine room No. 2 R/B with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 8.4 N*m (86 kgf*cm, 74 in.*lbf)
4.
INSTALL WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR AND LINK
ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the windshield wiper motor and link (see page
WW-15).
HINT:
Refer to the procedures from the installation of the
windshield wiper motor and link assembly up until
the installation of the front wiper arm LH/RH.
5.
FILL RESERVOIR WITH BRAKE FLUID (See page BR5)
6.
BLEED AIR FROM MASTER CYLINDER (See page
BR-5)
7.
BLEED AIR FROM MASTER CYLINDER/STROKE
SIMULATOR (See page BR-16)
8.
CHECK FOR BRAKE FLUID LEAKAGE
9.
CHECK BRAKE FLUID LEVEL IN RESERVOIR
F046090E01
10. CHECK AND ADJUST BRAKE PEDAL HEIGHT (See
page BR-22)
11. CHECK BRAKE PEDAL FREE PLAY (See page BR23)
12. CHECK BRAKE PEDAL RESERVE DISTANCE (See
page BR-24)
13. INSTALL LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page IP-13)
14. INSTALL NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-13)
15. CHECK AND CLEAR DTC
(a) Check and clear the DTC (see page BC-38).
BR
BR–34
BRAKE – BRAKE STROKE SIMULATOR CYLINDER
BRAKE STROKE SIMULATOR CYLINDER
BRAKE
COMPONENTS
6.4 (65, 57 in.*lbf)
OUTER FRONT COWL TOP
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
x7
ENGINE ROOM NO. 2
RELAY BLOCK
8.4 (86, 74 in.*lbf)
NO. 9 FRONT
BRAKE TUBE
BRAKE STROKE SIMULATOR
CYLINDER SUB-ASSEMBLY
15 (155, 11)
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
BRAKE ACTUATOR
TUBE ASSEMBLY
BRACKET
8.5 (87, 75 in.*lbf)
6.0 (61, 53 in.*lbf)
15 (155, 11)
8.5 (87, 75 in.*lbf)
BR
FRONT NO. 2 BRAKE TUBE
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C130369E02
BR–35
BRAKE – BRAKE STROKE SIMULATOR CYLINDER
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
NOTICE:
The DTC may be stored after inspection. Be sure to clear
the DTC and check that a normal system code is output
after the inspection is finished.
1.
INSPECT STROKE SIMULATOR
(a) Check battery voltage.
Standard battery voltage:
10 to 14 V (during engine stop)
(b) Connect intelligent tester and pedal effort gauge.
(1) Connect the pedal effort gauge.
(2) Move the shift lever to the P position. Apply the
parking brake and connect the intelligent tester
to the DLC3.
(3) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(4) Clear the DTC (see page BC-38).
(c) Check operation w/o brake booster.
(1) Check and adjust brake pedal height (see page
BR-22).
(2) Check pedal free play (see page BR-23).
(3) Check pedal reserve distance (see page BR24).
(4) Turn on the intelligent tester and select "ECB
INVALID" to prohibit the brake control (ECB).
(5) Monitor "MAS CYL PRS 1", "MAS CYL PRS 2",
"PEDAL STROKE" and "PEDAL STROKE 2"
using the intelligent tester.
(6) Check the value output from "MAS CYL PRS
1", "MAS CYL PRS 2", "PEDAL STROKE" and
"PEDAL STROKE 2" by depressing the brake
pedal.
Standard output voltage
Pedal Effort
N (kgf, lbf)
MAS CYL PRS 1
(V)
MAS CYL PRS 2
(V)
PEDAL STROKE
(V)
PEDAL STROKE 2
(V)
200 (20.4, 45)
0.9 to 1.2
0.9 to 1.2
1.7 to 2.1
2.9 to 3.3
500 (51, 112)
1.7 to 2.2
1.7 to 2.2
1.9 to 2.3
2.7 to 3.1
(7) Finish the brake control prohibition on the
intelligent tester.
(d) Check operation w/ brake booster.
(1) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(2) Turn on the intelligent tester and monitor the
value of "PEDAL STROKE" and "PEDAL
STROKE 2".
(3) Depress the brake pedal 4 to 5 times.
(4) Check the value output from "PEDAL
STROKE" and "PEDAL STROKE 2" by
depressing the brake pedal.
Standard output voltage
Pedal Effort
N (kgf, lbf)
PEDAL STROKE
(V)
PEDAL STROKE 2
(V)
50 (5.1, 11)
1.1 to 1.7
3.3 to 3.8
100 (10.2, 22)
1.3 to 1.8
3.2 to 3.7
BR
BR–36
BR
BRAKE – BRAKE STROKE SIMULATOR CYLINDER
Pedal Effort
N (kgf, lbf)
PEDAL STROKE
(V)
PEDAL STROKE 2
(V)
150 (15.3, 34)
1.4 to 1.8
3.2 to 3.6
200 (20.4, 45)
1.4 to 1.8
3.2 to 3.6
BRAKE – BRAKE STROKE SIMULATOR CYLINDER
BR–37
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR AND LINK
ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the windshield wiper motor and link (see
page WW-13).
HINT:
Refer to the procedures from the removal of the
front wiper arm LH/RH up until the removal of the
windshield wiper motor and link assembly.
2.
SET BRAKE CONTROL (ECB) OFF (See page BR-28)
3.
REMOVE OUTER FRONT COWL TOP PANEL SUBASSEMBLY (See page BR-28)
4.
DRAIN BRAKE FLUID
NOTICE:
Wash brake fluid off immediately if it adheres to any
painted surface.
5.
REMOVE BRAKE STROKE SIMULATOR CYLINDER
SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Using SST, disconnect the 2 brake tubes from the
brake simulator cylinder.
SST 09023-00101
(b) Disconnect the connector.
F046158E01
(c) Remove the 2 nuts, 2 bolts and brake stroke
simulator cylinder with bracket.
F046159E01
(d) Remove the 2 bolts, connector clamp and bracket
from the brake stroke simulator cylinder.
(e) Remove the 2 stud bolts from the brake stroke
simulator cylinder.
BR
F101068
BR–38
BRAKE – BRAKE STROKE SIMULATOR CYLINDER
INSTALLATION
1.
F101068
INSTALL BRAKE STROKE SIMULATOR CYLINDER
SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the 2 stud bolts to the brake stroke simulator
cylinder.
Torque: 5.0 N*m (51 kgf*cm, 44 in.*lbf)
(b) Install the brake stroke simulator cylinder to the
bracket with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 6.0 N*m (61 kgf*cm, 53 in.*lbf)
(c) Install the connector clamp of the brake stroke
simulator cylinder to the bracket.
(d) Install the brake stroke simulator cylinder with
bracket to the body with the 2 nuts and 2 bolts.
Torque: 8.5 N*m (87 kgf*cm, 75 in.*lbf)
F046159E01
(e) Using SST, connect the 2 brake tubes to the brake
stroke simulator cylinder.
SST 09023-00101
Torque: 15 N*m (155 kgf*cm, 11 ft.*lbf)
(f) Connect the connector.
2.
INSTALL OUTER FRONT COWL TOP PANEL SUBASSEMBLY (See page BR-32)
3.
INSTALL WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR AND LINK
ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the windshield wiper motor and link (see page
WW-15).
HINT:
Refer to the procedures from the installation of the
windshield wiper motor and link assembly up until
the installation of the front wiper arm LH/RH.
4.
FILL RESERVOIR WITH BRAKE FLUID (See page BR5)
5.
BLEED AIR FROM MASTER CYLINDER/STROKE
SIMULATOR (See page BR-16)
6.
CHECK FOR BRAKE FLUID LEAKAGE
7.
CHECK FLUID LEVEL IN RESERVOIR
8.
CHECK AND CLEAR DTC
(a) Check and clear the DTC (see page BC-38).
9.
PERFORM SYSTEM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform the brake system initialization (see page
BC-19).
F046158E01
BR
10. CHECK OPERATION (See page BR-35)
BR–39
BRAKE – FRONT BRAKE
FRONT BRAKE
BRAKE
COMPONENTS
FRONT DISC BRAKE BLEEDER PLUG CAP
34 (347, 25)
NO. 1 FLEXIBLE
HOSE
8.4 (86, 74 in.*lbf)
FRONT DISC BRAKE
BLEEDER PLUG
FRONT DISC
FRONT DISC BRAKE
CYLINDER SLIDE PIN
33 (337, 24)
FRONT DISC BRAKE
BUSH DUST BOOT
GASKET
FRONT DISC BRAKE
CYLINDER SUB-ASSEMBLY
NO. 1 FRONT DISC
BRAKE PAD
SUPPORT PLATE
SET RING
34 (347, 25)
109 (1,114, 81)
PISTON SEAL
CYLINDER BOOT
FRONT DISC
BRAKE PISTON
FRONT DISC BRAKE
CYLINDER SLIDE PIN
BUSH DUST BOOT
NO. 2 FRONT DISC
BRAKE PAD SUPPORT
PLATE
FRONT DISC BRAKE
CYLINDER MOUNTING LH
NO. 2 ANTI-SQUEAL SHIM
NO. 1 ANTI-SQUEAL SHIM
BR
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
NO. 2 ANTI-SQUEAL SHIM
Non-reusable part
NO. 1 ANTI-SQUEAL SHIM
Lithium soap base glycol grease
DISC brake grease
FRONT DISC BRAKE PAD
C130370E02
BR–40
BRAKE – FRONT BRAKE
REMOVAL
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the LH side and RH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
• If work that does not involve brake fluid bleeding, such as
disc brake pad replacement, is started 2 minutes or more
after the power switch is turned OFF, brake control (ECB)
prohibition is not necessary.
1.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
2.
SET BRAKE CONTROL (ECB) OFF (See page BR-28)
3.
DRAIN BRAKE FLUID
NOTICE:
Wash brake fluid off immediately if it adheres to any
painted surface.
4.
REMOVE FRONT DISC BRAKE CYLINDER SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the union bolt and gasket, and disconnect
the No. 1 flexible hose from the front disc brake
cylinder.
(b) Hold the front disc brake cylinder slide pin using a
wrench. Remove the 2 bolts and separate the front
disc brake cylinder.
5.
REMOVE FRONT DISC BRAKE PAD KIT (PAD ONLY)
(a) Remove the 2 front disc brake pads from the front
disc brake cylinder mounting.
6.
REMOVE FRONT ANTI-SQUEAL SHIM KIT
(a) Remove the 2 No. 1 anti-squeal shims and 2 No. 2
anti-squeal shims from the front disc brake pads.
7.
REMOVE NO. 1 FRONT DISC BRAKE PAD SUPPORT
PLATE
(a) Remove the No. 1 pad support plate from the front
disc brake cylinder mounting.
8.
REMOVE NO. 2 FRONT DISC BRAKE PAD SUPPORT
PLATE
(a) Remove the No. 2 pad support plate from the front
disc brake cylinder mounting.
9.
REMOVE FRONT DISC BRAKE CYLINDER SLIDE PIN
(a) Pull off the 2 front disc brake cylinder slide pins from
the front disc brake cylinder mounting.
F046161E01
10. REMOVE FRONT DISC BRAKE BUSH DUST BOOT
(a) Remove the 2 bush dust boots from the front disc
brake cylinder mounting.
BR
F046162E01
BRAKE – FRONT BRAKE
BR–41
11. REMOVE FRONT DISC BRAKE CYLINDER
MOUNTING LH
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and front disc brake cylinder
mounting.
F046163E01
BR
BR–42
BRAKE – FRONT BRAKE
DISASSEMBLY
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the LH side and RH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
REMOVE CYLINDER BOOT
(a) Remove the set ring and cylinder boot from the front
disc brake cylinder.
2.
REMOVE FRONT DISC BRAKE PISTON
(a) Place a wooden block wrapped in a cloth between
the front disc brake piston and front disc brake
cylinder to prevent them from being damaged.
(b) Put air into the front disc brake cylinder gradually so
that the piston does not protrude using compressed
air. Remove the front disc brake piston from the
front disc brake cylinder.
CAUTION:
Be careful not to pinch fingers.
NOTICE:
Do not spatter fluid.
3.
REMOVE PISTON SEAL
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the piston seal from
the front disc brake cylinder.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the inside of the cylinder or the
seal groove.
4.
REMOVE FRONT DISC BRAKE BLEEDER PLUG CAP
5.
REMOVE FRONT DISC BRAKE BLEEDER PLUG
6.
REMOVE FRONT DISC
HINT:
Put matchmarks on the disc and axle hub.
F046164E01
Wooden
Block
Cloth
F101069E01
F101056
Matchmark
BR
F101070E01
BRAKE – FRONT BRAKE
BR–43
INSPECTION
F101057
1.
INSPECT BRAKE CYLINDER AND PISTON
(a) Check that the side of the front disc brake piston
and the inside of the cylinder are not damaged.
If necessary, replace the front disc brake cylinder
and front disc brake piston.
2.
INSPECT PAD LINING THICKNESS
(a) Using a ruler, measure the pad lining thickness.
Standard thickness:
11.0 mm (0.433 in.)
Minimum thickness:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
HINT:
If the disc brake pad thickness is at the minimum or
less, replace the disc brake pad.
3.
INSPECT NO. 1 FRONT DISC BRAKE PAD SUPPORT
PLATE
(a) Clean the area where the No. 1 front disc brake
support plate contacts the brake pad using brake
cleaner. Check that there are no deformations,
cracks or rust.
(b) Check that there is no looseness or deformation
with the front disc brake cylinder mounting installed.
(c) Make sure that the support has sufficient rebound
when installing the pad. Check that the pad does not
easily drop after installation.
4.
INSPECT NO. 2 FRONT DISC BRAKE PAD SUPPORT
PLATE
HINT:
Check the No. 2 pad support plate using the same
inspection procedures for the No. 1 pad support plate.
5.
INSPECT DISC THICKNESS
(a) Using a micrometer, measure the disc thickness.
Standard thickness:
22.0 mm (0.866 in.)
Minimum thickness:
20.0 mm (0.787 in.)
HINT:
If the disc plate thickness is at the minimum or less,
replace the front disc.
F101071
BR
BR–44
BRAKE – FRONT BRAKE
REASSEMBLY
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the LH side and RH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
INSTALL FRONT DISC
(a) Align matchmarks on the disc and the axle hub.
Install the front disc.
NOTICE:
When installing a new disc, select the position
where the disc has the minimum runout.
2.
INSPECT DISC RUNOUT
(a) Check the looseness of the front wheel bearing and
runout in the axle hub before inspecting the disc
runout (see page AH-4).
(b) Hold the front disc with the 3 hub nuts.
Torque: 103 N*m (1,050 kgf*cm, 76 ft.*lbf)
(c) Holding a dial indicator 10 mm (0.394 in.) away from
the outer edge of the front disc, measure the disc
runout.
Maximum disc runout:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
NOTICE:
If the runout exceeds the maximum value,
change the installation positions of the disc and
axle so that the runout will become minimal. If
the runout exceeds even when the installation
positions are changed or if disc thickness does
not exceed the limit, shave the disc. If disc
thickness exceeds the limit, replace the disc.
3.
TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN FRONT DISC BRAKE
BLEEDER PLUG
4.
INSTALL FRONT DISC BRAKE BLEEDER PLUG CAP
5.
INSTALL PISTON SEAL
(a) Apply lithium soap base glycol grease around a new
piston seal and install it into the brake cylinder
groove securely.
6.
INSTALL FRONT DISC BRAKE PISTON
(a) Check the side of the front disc brake piston for any
scratch.
NOTICE:
Replace the front disc brake piston with a new
one if there is any scratch on it.
(b) Apply lithium soap base glycol grease to the inside
of a new cylinder boot and install it to the front disc
brake piston.
NOTICE:
Install the cylinder boot securely into the front
disc brake piston groove.
C097900E02
BR
F101058
BRAKE – FRONT BRAKE
BR–45
(c) Apply lithium soap base glycol grease around the
front disc brake piston and install it to the front disc
brake cylinder.
NOTICE:
• Do not install the piston forcibly into the front
disc brake cylinder.
• Do not damage the piston tip during
installation.
• Do not push the piston directly using hard or
sharp tools.
7.
F101072
INSTALL CYLINDER BOOT
(a) Install the cylinder boot to the disc brake cylinder
groove.
NOTICE:
Install the cylinder boot securely into the disc
brake cylinder and piston groove.
(b) Using a screwdriver, install a new front disc brake
piston set ring to the front disc brake cylinder.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the cylinder boot.
BR
BR–46
BRAKE – FRONT BRAKE
INSTALLATION
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the LH side and RH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
INSTALL FRONT DISC BRAKE CYLINDER
MOUNTING LH
(a) Install the front disc brake cylinder mounting with
the 2 bolts.
Torque: 109 N*m (1,114 kgf*cm, 81 ft.*lbf)
2.
INSTALL FRONT DISC BRAKE BUSH DUST BOOT
(a) Apply lithium soap base glycol grease to seal
surface of 2 new bush dust boots.
(b) Install the 2 bush dust boots to the front disc brake
cylinder mounting.
3.
INSTALL FRONT DISC BRAKE CYLINDER SLIDE PIN
(a) Apply lithium soap base glycol grease to the sliding
and fitting portion of the front disc brake cylinder
slide pin.
(b) Push the front disc brake cylinder slide pin into the
disc brake bush dust boot to install it.
4.
INSTALL NO. 1 FRONT DISC BRAKE PAD SUPPORT
PLATE
(a) Install the No. 1 pad support plate to the front disc
brake cylinder mounting.
5.
INSTALL NO. 2 FRONT DISC BRAKE PAD SUPPORT
PLATE
(a) Install the No. 2 pad support plate to the front disc
brake cylinder mounting.
6.
INSTALL FRONT ANTI-SQUEAL SHIM KIT
(a) Apply disc brake grease to the area where the No. 1
anti-squeal shim makes contact.
(b) Install the 2 No. 1 anti-squeal shims and 2 No. 2
anti-squeal shims to the front disc brake pads.
7.
INSTALL FRONT DISC BRAKE PAD KIT (PAD ONLY)
(a) Install the 2 front disc brake pads to the front disc
brake cylinder mounting.
F101059
F046162E01
BR
BRAKE – FRONT BRAKE
F046161E01
BR–47
8.
INSTALL FRONT DISC BRAKE CYLINDER SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Install the front disc brake cylinder with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 34 N*m (347 kgf*cm, 25 ft.*lbf)
(b) Placing a new gasket inbetween, connect the No. 1
flexible hose to the front disc brake cylinder with the
union bolt.
Torque: 33 N*m (337 kgf*cm, 24 ft.*lbf)
9.
FILL RESERVOIR WITH BRAKE FLUID (See page BR5)
10. BLEED AIR FROM FRONT AND REAR BRAKE
SYSTEMS (See page BR-5)
11. CHECK FOR BRAKE FLUID LEAKAGE
12. CHECK FLUID LEVEL IN RESERVOIR
13. INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
Torque: 103 N*m (1,050 kgf*cm, 76 ft.*lbf)
14. CHECK AND CLEAR DTC
(a) Check and clear the DTC (see page BC-38).
BR
BR–46
BRAKE – REAR DRUM BRAKE
REAR DRUM BRAKE
BRAKE
COMPONENTS
BLEEDER PLUG CAP
8.5 (85, 73 in.*lbf)
REAR DRUM BRAKE BLEEDER PLUG
WHEEL CYLINDER CUP
9.8 (100, 87 in.*lbf)
SHOE HOLD DOWN
SPRING PIN
PISTON
PISTON
CYLINDER
DUST BOOT
15 (155, 11)
NO. 4 REAR
BRAKE TUBE
WHEEL CYLINDER CUP
COMPRESSION SPRING
CYLINDER DUST BOOT
FRONT OR UPPER REAR WHEEL
BRAKE CYLINDER ASSEMBLY LH
REAR BRAKE PARKING
BRAKE SHOE LEVER
SUB-ASSEMBLY
C-WASHER
HOLE PLUG
PARKING BRAKE SHOE
STRUT SET LH
REAR BRAKE SHOE
INSPECTION PLUG
REAR BRAKE SHOE
FRONT BRAKE SHOE
REAR BRAKE AUTOMATIC
ADJUST LEVER LH
TENSION SPRING
REAR BRAKE
AUTOMATIC
ADJUST LEVER
TENSION SPRING
SHOE HOLD
DOWN SPRING
SHOE HOLD DOWN
SPRING CUP
BR
SHOE HOLD DOWN SPRING
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
SHOE HOLD DOWN
SPRING CUP
Non-reusable part
Lithium soap base glycol grease
High temperature grease
REAR BRAKE DRUM SUB-ASSEMBLY
C130371E02
BRAKE – REAR DRUM BRAKE
BR–47
REMOVAL
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the LH side and RH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
• If work that does not involve brake fluid bleeding, such as
drum brake shoe replacement, is started 2 minutes or
more after the power switch is turned OFF, brake control
(ECB) prohibition is not necessary.
Rear Bake
Automatic
Adjust Lever
Contract
F047456E01
1.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
2.
SET BRAKE CONTROL (ECB) OFF (See page BR-28)
3.
DRAIN BRAKE FLUID
NOTICE:
Wash brake fluid off immediately if it adheres to any
painted surfaces.
4.
REMOVE REAR BRAKE DRUM SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Put matchmarks on the rear brake drum and the
axle hub.
(b) Release the parking brake and remove the rear
brake drum.
HINT:
If the rear brake drum cannot be removed, push the
rear brake automatic adjust lever through the
backing plate service hole using a screwdriver. Turn
and contract the adjuster using another screwdriver.
BR
BR–48
BRAKE – REAR DRUM BRAKE
DISASSEMBLY
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the LH side and RH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
DISCONNECT PARKING BRAKE SHOE STRUT SET
LH
(a) Using SST, disconnect the spring and parking brake
shoe strut set from the brake shoes.
SST 09703-30011
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the cylinder dust boot.
2.
REMOVE FRONT BRAKE SHOE
(a) Using SST, remove the cup, shoe hold down spring
and pin.
SST 09718-00010
(b) Remove the front brake shoe and tension spring.
3.
REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE STRUT SET LH
(a) Remove the parking brake shoe strut set from the
rear brake shoe.
4.
REMOVE REAR BRAKE AUTOMATIC ADJUST
LEVER LH
(a) Remove the rear brake automatic adjust lever
tension spring and the rear brake automatic adjust
lever.
5.
REMOVE REAR BRAKE SHOE
(a) Remove the tension spring from the rear brake
shoe.
(b) Using SST, remove the cup, shoe hold down spring
and pin.
SST 09718-00010
SST
F047457E02
SST
F101074E01
F101060
SST
BR
F047459E01
BRAKE – REAR DRUM BRAKE
BR–49
(c) Using needle-nose pliers, disconnect the parking
brake cable, and remove the rear brake shoe.
F101075
6.
REMOVE REAR BRAKE PARKING BRAKE SHOE
LEVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the C-washer and
parking brake shoe lever.
7.
REMOVE FRONT OR UPPER REAR WHEEL BRAKE
CYLINDER ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Using SST, disconnect the brake line.
SST 09023-00101
HINT:
Use a container to catch the brake fluid.
(b) Remove the bolt and the rear wheel brake cylinder.
8.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL CYLINDER CUP KIT
(a) Remove the 2 cylinder dust boots from the rear
wheel brake cylinder.
(b) Remove the 2 pistons and the compression spring.
(c) Remove the 2 wheel cylinder cups from each piston.
9.
REMOVE REAR DRUM BRAKE BLEEDER PLUG
(a) Remove the rear drum bleeder plug from the rear
wheel cylinder.
F101061
F101063
INSPECTION
1.
F101073
INSPECT BRAKE DRUM INSIDE DIAMETER
(a) Using a brake drum gauge or equivalent, measure
the inside diameter of the drum.
Standard inside diameter:
200.0 mm (7.874 in.)
Maximum inside diameter:
201.0 mm (7.913 in.)
HINT:
If the inside diameter of the brake drum is at the
maximum or more, replace the rear brake drum subassembly.
BR
BR–50
BRAKE – REAR DRUM BRAKE
2.
INSPECT REAR DRUM BRAKE SHOE LINING
THICKNESS
(a) Using a ruler, measure the thickness of the shoe
lining.
Standard thickness:
4.0 mm (0.157 in.)
Minimum thickness:
1.0 mm (0.039in.)
If the lining thickness is at the minimum thickness or
less, or if there is severe or uneven wear, replace
the brake shoe.
3.
INSPECT BRAKE DRUM AND REAR DRUM BRAKE
SHOE LINING FOR PROPER CONTACT
(a) Apply chalk to the inside surface of the drum, then
grind the drum on the brake shoe lining to fit.
If the contact between the drum and the shoe lining
is improper, repair it using a brake shoe grinder or
replace the brake shoe.
4.
INSPECT BRAKE WHEEL CYLINDER
(a) Check the cylinder bore and the piston for rust or
scoring.
If necessary, replace the rear wheel brake cylinder
assembly.
F101076
F101077
BR
BRAKE – REAR DRUM BRAKE
BR–51
REASSEMBLY
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the LH side and RH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN REAR DRUM BRAKE
BLEEDER PLUG
(a) Install the rear drum brake bleeder plug to the rear
wheel brake cylinder.
2.
INSTALL REAR WHEEL CYLINDER CUP KIT
(a) Apply lithium soap base glycol grease to 2 new
wheel cylinder cups and 2 pistons.
(b) Install the 2 wheel cylinder cups on each piston.
(c) Install the compression spring and the 2 pistons to
the rear wheel brake cylinder.
(d) Install the 2 new cylinder dust boots to the rear
wheel brake cylinder.
3.
INSTALL FRONT OR UPPER REAR WHEEL BRAKE
CYLINDER ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the rear wheel brake cylinder with the bolt.
Torque: 9.8 N*m (100 kgf*cm, 87 in.*lbf)
(b) Using SST, connect the brake line.
SST 09023-00101
Torque: 15 N*m (155 kgf*cm, 11 ft.*lbf)
4.
APPLY HIGH TEMPERATURE GREASE
(a) Apply high temperature grease to the shoe attached
surface of the backing plate.
Lithium Soap Base Glycol Grease
F101062E02
F101063
BR
High Temperature Grease
F101065E02
BR–52
BRAKE – REAR DRUM BRAKE
5.
INSTALL REAR BRAKE PARKING BRAKE SHOE
LEVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Using needle-nose pliers, install the parking brake
lever with a new C-washer.
6.
INSTALL REAR BRAKE SHOE
(a) Using needle-nose pliers, connect the No. 3 parking
brake cable to the parking brake shoe lever.
F101078
F045648E01
(b) Using SST, install the rear brake shoe, pin, shoe
hold down spring and cup.
SST 09718-00010
SST
7.
INSTALL REAR BRAKE SHOE RETURN SPRING
(a) Install the rear brake shoe return spring to the rear
brake shoe.
8.
INSTALL REAR BRAKE AUTOMATIC ADJUST
LEVER LH
(a) Install the rear brake automatic adjust lever and the
rear brake automatic adjust lever tension spring to
the front brake shoe.
9.
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE STRUT SET LH
(a) Apply high temperature grease to the adjusting bolt
and assemble the strut set.
(b) Install the shoe return spring to the strut set.
F045280E03
F101060
BR
High Temperature Grease
F101064E02
BRAKE – REAR DRUM BRAKE
BR–53
(c) Install the strut set as shown in the illustration.
Backing Plate
Parking Brake Shoe Strut Set
F101079E01
10. INSTALL FRONT BRAKE SHOE
(a) Connect the tension spring to the front brake shoe
and rear brake shoe.
(b) Using SST, install the front brake shoe, pin, shoe
hold down spring and cup.
SST 09718-00010
SST
F045279E03
11. CONNECT PARKING BRAKE SHOE STRUT SET LH
(a) Using SST, connect the shoe return spring to the
front brake shoe and rear brake shoe.
SST 09703-30011
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the wheel cylinder
boot.
SST
F045278E03
12. CHECK REAR DRUM BRAKE INSTALLATION
(a) Check that each part is installed properly.
NOTICE:
There should be no oil or grease adhering to the
friction surfaces of the shoe lining and drum.
If they are not installed correctly as shown in the
illustration, reinstall them.
BR
BR–54
BRAKE – REAR DRUM BRAKE
for LH
for RH
Front
Front
F040022E03
(b) Measure the brake drum inside diameter and the
diameter of the brake shoes. Check that the
difference between the diameter is the correct shoe
clearance.
Standard shoe clearance:
0.6 mm (0.024 in.)
NOTICE:
There should be no oil or grease adhering to the
friction surfaces of the shoe lining and the
drum.
F045281E01
BR
BRAKE – REAR DRUM BRAKE
BR–55
INSTALLATION
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the LH side and RH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
Rear Brake
Automatic Adjust
Lever
Expand
1.
INSTALL REAR BRAKE DRUM SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Aligning the matchmarks, install the rear brake
drum.
2.
ADJUST REAR DRUM BRAKE SHOE CLEARANCE
(a) Temporarily install 2 hub nuts.
(b) Remove the hole plug, and turn the adjuster to
expand the shoe until the drum locks.
(c) Rotate the adjuster by 8 notches.
(d) Install the hole plug.
(e) Remove the 2 hub nuts.
3.
FILL RESERVOIR WITH BRAKE FLUID (See page BR5)
4.
BLEED AIR FROM FRONT AND REAR BRAKE
SYSTEMS (See page BR-5)
5.
CHECK FOR BRAKE FLUID LEAKAGE
6.
CHECK FLUID LEVEL IN RESERVOIR
7.
INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 103 N*m (1,050 kgf*cm, 76 ft.*lbf)
8.
CHECK PARKING BRAKE PEDAL TRAVEL (See page
PB-1)
9.
ADJUST PARKING BRAKE PEDAL TRAVEL (See
page PB-1)
F040023E04
10. CHECK AND CLEAR DTC
(a) Check and clear the DTC (see page BC-38).
BR
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CA–1
CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
1.
2.
3.
STEERING SYSTEM HANDLING PRECAUTIONS
(a) Care must be taken when replacing parts. Incorrect
replacement could affect the performance of the
steering system and result in a driving hazard.
SRS AIRBAG SYSTEM HANDLING PRECAUTIONS
(a) The vehicle is equipped with an SRS (Supplemental
Restraint System) such as the driver's airbag and
front passenger airbag. Failure to carry out service
operations in correct sequence could cause
unexpected SRS deployment during servicing and
may lead to a serious accident. Before servicing
(including installation/removal, inspection and
replacement of parts), be sure to read the
precautionary notice for the supplemental restraint
system (see page RS-1).
CONNECTOR HANDLING
(a) When inserting tester probes into a connector, insert
them from the rear of the connector.
Tester Probe
E120443E01
Repair Wire
4.
(b) Use a repair wire to check the connector if it is
impossible to check continuity from the rear of the
connector.
PRECAUTION FOR DISCONNECTING THE BATTERY
CABLE
NOTICE:
When disconnecting the negative (-) battery
terminal, initialize the following system after the
terminal is reconnected.
E120444E01
System Name
See procedure
Power Window Control System
IN-32
CA
CA–2
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
STEERING ANGLE SENSOR
GATEWAY ECU
POWER STEERING ECU
ECM
SKID CONTROL ECU
HYBRID VEHICLE
CONTROL ECU
DLC3
J/C2 (JUNCTION CONNECTOR)
J/C1 (JUNCTION CONNECTOR)
YAW RATE SENSOR
CA
C127514E02
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CA–3
BATTERY ECU
C127513E03
CA
CA–4
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
CAN Main Wire (CANH)
ECM
CAN Main Wire (CANL)
120 Ω +-10%
CAN Branch Wire (CANH)
CAN Branch Wire (CANL)
Yaw Rate Sensor*
Hybrid Vehicle Control
ECU
Gateway ECU
J/C2 (Junction Connector)
Power Steering ECU
Steering Angle Sensor*
DLC3
Skid Control ECU
J/C1 (Junction Connector)
*: w/ Enhanced VSC
120 Ω +-10%
CA
Battery ECU
Serial Communication Line (SIL)
C126158E03
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CA–5
HINT:
• The skid control ECU detects and stores steering sensor
and yaw rate sensor DTCs and performs DTC
communication by receiving information from the steering
sensor and yaw rate sensor.
• The ECM, hybrid vehicle control ECU, and battery ECU
use the CAN communication system to perform DTC
communication instead of the conventional communication
line (SIL).
CA
CA–6
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
2.
3.
4.
CA
BRIEF DESCRIPTION
(a) The CAN (Controller Area Network) is a serial data
communication system for real time application. It is
a multiplex communication system equipped for a
vehicle and has a high communication speed (500
kbps) and a function to detect malfunctions.
(b) By pairing the CANH and CANL bus lines, the CAN
performs communication based on differential
voltage.
(c) The many ECUs (sensors) installed on the vehicle
operate by sharing information and communicating
with each other.
(d) The CAN has 2 resistors of 120 Ω which are
necessary to communicate with the main wire.
DEFINITION OF TERMS
(a) Main wire
(1) The main wire is the wire harness between the 2
terminus circuits on the bus (communication
line). This is the main bus in the CAN
communication system.
(b) Branch wire
(1) The branch wire is the wire harness which
diverges from the main wire to the ECU or
sensor.
(c) Terminus circuit
(1) The terminus circuit is a circuit which is placed to
convert communication current of the CAN
communication into bus voltage. It consists of a
resistor and condenser. 2 terminus circuits are
necessary on a bus.
ECUS OR SENSORS WHICH COMMUNICATE
THROUGH CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
(a) Hybrid Vehicle Control ECU
(b) Battery ECU
(c) ECM
(d) Skid Control ECU
(e) Steering Angle Sensor
(f) Yaw Rate Sensor
(g) Power Steering ECU
(h) Gateway ECU
DIAGNOSTIC CODE FOR CAN COMMUNICATION
SYSTEM
(a) DTCs for the CAN communication system are as
follows: U0123, U0124, U0126, U0293, U0100,
U0073, U0111, U0129, U0131, U0146, P3108-594
NOTICE:
If U0146 or P3108-594 is output, the multiplex
communication system may be malfunctioning.
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
5.
CA–7
REMARKS FOR TROUBLESHOOTING
(a) Trouble in the CAN bus (communication line) can be
checked from the DLC3 (except when there is a
wire break other than in the branch wire of the
DLC3).
NOTICE:
Do not insert the tester directly into the DLC3
connector. Be sure to use a service wire.
(b) DTCs regarding the CAN communication system
can be checked using the intelligent tester via the
CAN VIM.
(c) The CAN communication system cannot detect
trouble in the branch wire of the DLC3 even though
the DLC3 is also connected to the CAN
communication system.
CA
CA–8
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
NOTICE:
• Refer to the troubleshooting procedures of each
system if DTCs regarding the CAN communication
system are not output.
• If U0100-211 or U0111-208 is output separately by the
hybrid vehicle control ECU, refer to "HYBRID
CONTROL SYSTEM" (see page HV-515).
HINT:
*: Use the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM).
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
INSPECT BATTERY VOLTAGE
Standard voltage:
11 to 14 V
If the voltage is below 11 V, recharge or replace the battery
before proceeding.
NEXT
3
CHECK CAN BUS LINE
(a) Check the CAN bus line (see page CA-38).
NEXT
4
CHECK FOR INSTALLED SYSTEMS (ECU & SENSOR) THAT USE CAN COMMUNICATION
(a) Check if the enhanced VSC is installed (see page CA16).
NEXT
5
CHECK AND CLEAR DTC*
NEXT
CA
6
PERFORM BUS CHECK WITH INTELLIGENT TESTER
(a) Select the "BUS CHECK" (see page CA-16).
Result
Result
Proceed to
All ECUs and sensors connected to the CAN communication system
are displayed.
A
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
Result
Proceed to
An ECU or sensor not connected to the CAN communication system
is displayed.
B
CA–9
NOTICE:
• See "MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM"
(page MP-7) if U0146 (Lost Communication with
Gateway "A") and P3108-594 (Lost
Communication with A/C System Control Module)
are output and "BODY / GATEWAY" appears on
the "BUS CHECK" screen of the intelligent tester
via the CAN VIM.
• The systems (ECUs, sensors) that use CAN
communication vary depending on the vehicle
and option settings. Check which systems (ECUs,
sensors) are installed on the vehicle (see page
CA-16).
• Non-installed ECUs or sensors are not displayed.
Do not mistake them for being in the
communication stop mode.
B
GO TO PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(COMMUNICATION STOP MODE TABLE)
A
7
DTC COMBINATION TABLE
(a) Confirm the trouble according to the combination of
output DTCs regarding the CAN communication system.
HINT:
Previous CAN communication system DTCs may be the
cause if CAN communication system DTCs are output
and all ECUs and sensors connected to the CAN
communication system are displayed on the intelligent
tester's "BUS CHECK" screen via the CAN VIM.
(b) Check DTC combination table (see page CA-8).
NEXT
8
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
NEXT
9
NEXT
IDENTIFICATION OF PROBLEM
CA
CA–10
10
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
REPAIR OR REPLACE
NEXT
11
NEXT
END
CA
CONFIRMATION TEST
CA–11
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Result list of how to proceed with troubleshooting
Symptom
Suspected area
See page
Open in CAN Main Wire
CHECK CAN MAIN WIRE DISCONNECTION
CA-41
Short in CAN Bus Line
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT CIRCUIT
CA-47
Short to B+ CAN Bus Line
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO B+
CA-59
Short to GND in CAN Bus Line
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND
CA-70
Communication stop mode table
Symptom
Suspected area
See page
HYBRID CONTROL is not displayed on intelligent
tester via CAN VIM.
HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU COMMUNICATION
STOP MODE
CA-21
ABS / VSC / TRAC is not displayed on intelligent tester
via CAN VIM.
SKID CONTROL ECU COMMUNICATION STOP MODE
CA-23
STEERING SENSOR is not displayed on intelligent
tester via CAN VIM.
STEERING ANGLE SENSOR COMMUNICATION STOP
MODE
CA-30
YAW / DECELERAT is not displayed on intelligent
tester via CAN VIM.
YAW RATE SENSOR COMMUNICATION STOP MODE
CA-32
EPS is not displayed on intelligent tester via CAN VIM.
POWER STEERING ECU COMMUNICATION STOP MODE
CA-26
BODY / GATEWAY is not displayed on intelligent tester
via CAN VIM.
GATEWAY ECU COMMUNICATION STOP MODE
CA-28
ENGINE is not displayed on intelligent tester via CAN
VIM.
ECM ECU COMMUNICATION STOP MODE
CA-34
HV BATTERY is not displayed on intelligent tester via
CAN VIM.
BATTERY ECU COMMUNICATION STOP MODE
CA-36
CA
CA–12
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
TERMINALS OF ECU
HINT:
This section describes the standard CAN values for all CAN
related components.
1. JUNCTION CONNECTOR (J/C1)
CANL (for Skid Control ECU)
CANL (for DLC3)
CANL (for Power Steering ECU)
CANL (for Steering Angle Sensor)
CANL (for J/C2)
CANL (for Battery ECU)
J15
CANH (for Steering Angle Sensor)
CANH (for Battery ECU)
CANH (for DLC3)
CANH (for J/C2)
CANH (for Skid Control ECU)
CANH (for Power Steering ECU)
F100894E35
(a) Terminal arrangement and connection.
CA
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Connects to
CANL (J15-6)
J/C2
CANH (J15-17)
J/C2
CANL (J15-7)
Power Steering ECU
CANH (J15-18)
Power Steering ECU
CANL (J15-8)
Battery ECU
CANH (J15-19)
Battery ECU
CANL (J15-9)
Steering Angle Sensor
CANH (J15-20)
Steering Angle Sensor
CANL (J15-10)
DLC3
CANH (J15-21)
DLC3
CANL (J15-11)
Skid Control ECU
CANH (J15-22)
Skid Control ECU
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
2.
CA–13
JUNCTION CONNECTOR (J/C2)
CANL (for Hybrid Vehicle Control ECU)
CANL (for ECM)
CANL (for J/C1)
CANL (for Gateway ECU)
CANL (for Yaw Rate Sensor)
J18
CANH (for Gateway ECU)
CANH (for J/C1)
CANH (for ECM)
CANH (for Yaw Rate Sensor)
CANH (for Hybrid Vehicle Control ECU)
F100894E22
(a) Terminal arrangement and connection
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Connects to
CANL (J18-7)
J/C1
CANH (J18-18)
J/C1
CANL (J18-8)
Yaw Rate Sensor
CANH (J18-19)
Yaw Rate Sensor
CANL (J18-9)
Gateway ECU
CANH (J18-20)
Gateway ECU
CANL (J18-10)
ECM
CANH (J18-21)
ECM
CANL (J18-11)
Hybrid Vehicle Control ECU
CANH (J18-22)
Hybrid Vehicle Control ECU
3.
CG
D1
CANL
CANH
CHECK DLC3
(a) Measure the resistance of the connector.
BAT
CA
H100769E12
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Condition
Specified Condition
CANH (D1-6) - CANL (D1-4)
B-W
Power switch OFF
54 to 69 Ω
CANH (D1-6) - CG (D1-4)
B - W-B
Power switch OFF
1 kΩ or more
CANL (D1-14) - CG (D1-4)
W - W-B
Power switch OFF
1 kΩ or more
CANH (D1-6) - BAT (D1-16)
B-G
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
CANL (D1-14) - BAT (D1-16)
W-G
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
CA–14
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
4.
CHECK HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
H15
BATT
GND1
CANH
CANL
H14
C126159E02
(a) Disconnect the H14 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Condition
Specified Condition
CANH (H14-8) - CANL (H10-9)
B-W
Power switch OFF
54 to 69 Ω
CANH (H14-8) - GND1 (H10-1)
B - W-B
Power switch OFF
1 kΩ or more
CANL (H14-9) - GND1 (H10-1)
W - W-B
Power switch OFF
1 kΩ or more
CANH (H14-8) - BATT (H15-6)
B-Y
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
CANL (H14-9) - BATT (H15-6)
W-Y
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
5.
CHECK BATTERY ECU
B11
CANL
CANH
C126160E01
CA
(a) Measure the resistance of the connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Condition
Specified Condition
CANH (B11-18) - CANL (B11-19)
Power switch OFF
108 to 132 Ω
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CA–15
(b) Disconnect the B11 ECU connector.
GND
B11
AM
CANL
CANH
C126161E04
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Condition
Specified Condition
CANH (B11-18) - CANL (B11-19)
B-W
Power switch OFF
108 to 132 Ω
CANH (B11-18) - GND (B11-12)
B - W-B
Power switch OFF
1 kΩ or more
CANL (B11-19) - GND (B11-12)
W - W-B
Power switch OFF
1 kΩ or more
CANH (B11-18) - AM (B11-1)
B-G
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
CANL (B11-19) - AM (B11-1)
W-G
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
6.
E4
CHECK ECM
E5
E7
E6
CANH
CANL
C126162E02
(a) Measure the resistance of the connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Condition
Specified Condition
CANH (E6-31) - CANL (E6-30)
Power switch OFF
108 to 132 Ω
(b) Disconnect the E6 ECM connector.
CA
CA–16
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
E01
BATT
E7
E4
CANH
CANL
E6
C126163E02
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Condition
Specified Condition
CANH (E6-31) - CANL (E6-30)
B-W
Power switch OFF
108 to 132 Ω
CANH (E6-31) - E01 (E4-7)
B - BR
Power switch OFF
1 kΩ or more
CANL (E6-30) - E01 (E4-7)
W - BR
Power switch OFF
1 kΩ or more
CANH (E6-31) - BATT (E7-6)
B-R
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
CANL (E6-30) - BATT (E7-6)
W-R
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
7.
GND
S7
CANH
CHECK SKID CONTROL ECU
S8
+BI1
CANL
C126164E02
(a) Disconnect the S8 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
CA
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Condition
Specified Condition
CANH (S8-19) - CANL (S8-18)
B-W
Power switch OFF
54 to 69 Ω
CANH (S8-19) - GND (S7-1)
B-W
Power switch OFF
1 kΩ or more
CANL (S8-18) - GND (S7-1)
W-W
Power switch OFF
1 kΩ or more
CANH (S8-19) - +BI1 (S8-3)
B-B
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
CANL (S8-18) - +BI1 (S8-3)
W-B
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
8.
CA–17
CHECK POWER STEERING ECU
PIG
PGND
CANH
P7
P8
CANL
C126165E02
(a) Disconnect the P8 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Condition
Specified Condition
CANH (P8-1) - CANL (P8-7)
B-W
Power switch OFF
54 to 69 Ω
CANH (P8-1) - PGND (P7-2)
B - W-B
Power switch OFF
1 kΩ or more
CANL (P8-7) - PGND (P7-2)
W - W-B
Power switch OFF
1 kΩ or more
CANH (P8-1) - PIG (P7-1)
B-W
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
CANL (P8-7) - PIG (P7-1)
W-W
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
9.
CHECK GATEWAY ECU
BATT
G1
GND
CA1L
CA1H
C126166E02
(a) Disconnect the G1 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Condition
Specified Condition
CA1H (G1-17) - CA1L (G1-18)
B-W
Power switch OFF
54 to 69 Ω
CA1H (G1-17) - GND (G1-24)
B - W-B
Power switch OFF
1 kΩ or more
CA1L (G1-18) - GND (G1-24)
W - W-B
Power switch OFF
1 kΩ or more
CA1H (G1-17) - BATT (G1-10)
B-Y
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
CA1L (G1-18) - BATT (G1-10)
W-Y
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
CA
CA–18
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
10. CHECK STEERING ANGLE SENSOR
S13
10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
ESS
CANH
CANL
BAT
C126167E02
(a) Disconnect the S13 sensor connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Condition
Specified Condition
CANH (S13-10) - CANL (S13-9)
B-W
Power switch OFF
54 to 69 Ω
CANH (S13-10) - ESS (S13-2)
B - W-B
Power switch OFF
1 kΩ or more
CANL (S13-9) - ESS (S13-2)
W - W-B
Power switch OFF
1 kΩ or more
CANH (S13-10) - BAT (S13-3)
B-R
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
CANL (S13-9) - BAT (S13-3)
W-R
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
11. CHECK YAW RATE SENSOR
Yaw Rate Sensor
D1
Y1
GND
BAT
CANL CANH
C128521E01
(a) Disconnect the Y1 sensor connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
CA
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Condition
Specified Condition
CANH (Y1-3) - CANL (Y1-2)
B-W
Power switch OFF
54 to 69 Ω
CANH (Y1-3) - GND (Y1-1)
B - W-B
Power switch OFF
1 kΩ or more
CANL (Y1-2) - GND (Y1-1)
W - W-B
Power switch OFF
1 kΩ or more
CANH (Y1-3) - BAT (D1-16)
B-G
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
CANL (Y1-2) - BAT (D1-16)
W-G
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CA–19
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
1.
BUS CHECK
HINT:
The ECUs and sensors that are properly connected to
the CAN communication system can be displayed using
the intelligent tester via the CAN VIM.
(a) Select "BUS CHECK" from the "OBD / MOBD
MENU" screen.
C125139
(b) Press "ENTER" on the intelligent tester via the CAN
VIM.
C125140
2.
C125141
(c) The screen displays the ECUs and sensors that are
properly connected to the CAN communication
system.
HINT:
There is a communication stop in the system of any
properly connected ECUs or sensors that are not
displayed (see page CA-8).
CHECK FOR INSTALLED SYSTEMS (ECU &
SENSOR) THAT USE CAN COMMUNICATION
(a) The systems (ECU, sensor) that use CAN
communication vary depending on the vehicle's
optional settings. Check which systems (ECU,
sensor) are installed on the vehicle.
ECU / Sensor name
Installed to
Hybrid Vehicle Control ECU
All vehicles
Battery ECU
All vehicles
ECM
All vehicles
Skid Control ECU
All vehicles
Power Steering ECU
All vehicles
Gateway ECU
All vehicles
Steering Angle Sensor
Vehicle with enhanced VSC (VSC warning light is installed in
combination meter)
Yaw Rate Sensor
Vehicle with enhanced VSC (VSC warning light is installed in
combination meter)
HINT:
If enhanced VSC is not installed, neither the yaw
rate sensor nor the steering angle sensor is used.
CA
CA–20
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
3.
DTC TABLE BY ECU
HINT:
If CAN communication system DTCs are output, trouble
cannot be determined only by the DTCs. Perform
troubleshooting according to "HOW TO PROCEED
WITH TROUBLESHOOTING" (see page CA-6).
(a) HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
HINT:
DTC communication uses the CAN communication
system.
DTC No.
Information Code
Detection Item
U0100
211, 212, 530
Lost Communication With ECM / PCM "A"
U0111
208, 531
Lost Communication With Battery Energy
Control Module "A"
U0129
220, 222, 528, 529
Lost Communication With Brake System
Control Module
U0131
433, 434
Lost Communication With Power Steering
Control Module
U0146
435
Lost Communication With Gateway "A"
P3108
594
Lost Communication With A/C System
Control Module
(b) BATTERY ECU
HINT:
DTC communication uses the CAN communication
system.
DTC No.
Detection Item
U0100
Lost Communication With ECM / PCM "A"
U0293
Lost Communication With Hybrid Vehicle Control System
(c) ECM
HINT:
DTC communication uses the CAN communication
system.
DTC No.
Detection Item
U0293
Lost Communication With Hybrid Vehicle Control System
(d) SKID CONTROL ECU
HINT:
DTC communication uses the SIL line.
CA
DTC No.
Information Code
Detection Item
U0293
152, 153, 154
Lost Communication With Hybrid Vehicle
Control System
U0073
360
Control Module Communication Bus Off
U0123
-
Lost Communication With Yaw Rate Sensor
Module
U0124
-
Lost Communication With Lateral
Acceleration Sensor Module
U0126
-
Lost Communication With Steering Angle
Sensor Module
w/ Enhanced VSC
CA–21
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
(e) GATEWAY ECU
HINT:
The gateway ECU is connected to the CAN
communication system but CAN communication
system DTCs are not output.
(f) POWER STEERING ECU
HINT:
DTC communication uses the SIL line.
DTC No.
Detection Item
U0073
Control Module Communication Bus Off
U0121
Lost Communication With Anti-Lock Brake System (ABS) Control
Module
4.
DTC
DTC COMBINATION TABLE
(a) Perform troubleshooting according to the
combination of DTCs output.
Detected Communication Stop Mode
Output
from
Output
DTC
HYBRID
VEHICL
E
CONTR
OL ECU
COMMU
NICATIO
N STOP
MODE
ECM
COMMU
NICATIO
N STOP
MODE
BATTER
Y ECU
COMMU
NICATIO
N STOP
MODE
SKID
CONTROL
ECU
COMMUNICAT
ION STOP
MODE
STEERING
ANGLE
SENSOR
COMMUNICAT
ION STOP
MODE
YAW RATE
SENSOR
COMMUNICAT
ION STOP
MODE
POWER
STEERING
ECU
COMMUNICAT
ION STOP
MODE
GATEW
AY ECU
COMMU
NICATIO
N STOP
MODE
Hybrid
Vehicle
Control
ECU
U0100
-
{
X
X
X
X
X
X
U0111
-
X
{
X
X
X
X
X
U0129
-
X
X
{
X
X
X
X
U0146
-
X
X
X
X
X
X
{
P3108594
-
X
X
X
X
X
X
{
ECM
U0293
{
-
X
X
X
X
X
X
Battery
ECU
U0100
X
{
-
X
X
X
X
X
U0293
{
X
-
X
X
X
X
X
Skid
Control
ECU
U0123
X
X
X
-
X
{
X
X
U0124
X
X
X
-
X
{
X
X
U0126
X
X
X
-
{
X
X
X
U0293
{
X
X
-
X
x
X
X
U0121
X
X
X
{
X
X
-
X
Power
Steering
ECU
HINT:
{: Outputs
x: Not output
-: Undetectable
NOTICE:
• If U0146 or P3108-594 is output, check the
"MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM"
(see page MP-7) before proceeding to
"GATEWAY ECU COMMUNICATION STOP
MODE".
CA
CA–22
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
• If U0100-211 or U0111-208 is output
separately by the hybrid control ECU, refer to
"HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM" (see page HV515).
HINT:
• HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
COMMUNICATION STOP MODE (see page CA21 ).
• ECM COMMUNICATION STOP MODE (see
page CA-34).
• BATTERY ECU COMMUNICATION STOP
MODE (see page CA-36).
• SKID CONTROL ECU COMMUNICATION STOP
MODE (see page CA-23).
• STEERING ANGLE SENSOR
COMMUNICATION STOP MODE (see page CA30).
• YAW RATE SENSOR COMMUNICATION STOP
MODE (see page CA-32).
• POWER STEERING ECU COMMUNICATION
STOP MODE (see page CA-26).
• GATEWAY ECU COMMUNICATION STOP
MODE (see page CA-28).
CA
CA–23
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
FAIL-SAFE CHART
1.
Function
Hybrid
Vehicle
Control
ECU
ECM
Battery
ECU
Skid
Control
ECU
TOYOTA
hybrid
system
control
(Optimum
mix of the
electric
motor and
gas
engine)
z
{
{
Regenerat
ive braking
(Drives the
motor as a
generator
using the
electricity
produced
by the
wheel's
rotation.
The
electricity
is stored in
the HV
battery)
{
z
Enhanced
VSC
control
(Controls
braking
force
when
enhanced
VSC is in
operation)
{
z
FAIL-SAFE FUNCTION
(a) The fail-safe function starts if any bus
(communication line) fails due to a short or other
type of circuit failure. The fail-safe function differs in
each system and ensures the minimum required
function for each system.
(b) The table below shows the effects on each system
when communication is impossible. For further
details, refer to each system.
Steering
Angle
Sensor
{
Yaw Rate
Sensor
{
Power
Steering
ECU
Gateway
ECU
Action
when
unable to
communi
cate
DTC
detectio
n (Driver
detectab
le)
Restricted
driving
Detectabl
e (Light
comes
on)
Prohibits
regenerati
on
Detectabl
e (Light
comes
on)
Stops
enhanced
VSC
Detectabl
e (Light
comes
on)
CA
CA–24
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
ECM
Function
Hybrid
Vehicle
Control
ECU
Electric
power
steering
(Calculate
s assist
current
according
to the
torque
sensor
value and
vehicle
speed,
then
sends the
data to the
motor)
{
Display
(Operating
condition,
shift
position,
DTC)
{
{
A/C
control
{
{
Battery
ECU
Skid
Control
ECU
Steering
Angle
Sensor
Yaw Rate
Sensor
Power
Steering
ECU
{
z
{
{
Action
when
unable to
communi
cate
DTC
detectio
n (Driver
detectab
le)
Maintains
control by
locking
amount of
power
assist to
70 km/h
(43 mph)
level of
power
assist.
Detectabl
e (Light
comes
on)
z
Meter
Light does
not come
on or
remains
on
Detectabl
e by
illuminati
on
malfuncti
on
z
A/C
Control of
A/C to
level set
not
possible
Detectabl
e (Light
does not
come on)
Gateway
ECU
HINT:
• z: Control master ECU
• {: Related ECU or sensor
CA
CA–25
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
Hybrid Vehicle Control ECU Communication Stop Mode
DESCRIPTION
Detection Item
Symptom
Trouble Area
HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
COMMUNICATION STOP MODE
•
•
•
HYBRID CONTROL is not displayed on
"BUS CHECK" screen of intelligent tester.
Applies to "HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL
ECU COMMUNICATION STOP MODE"
in "DTC COMBINATION TABLE".
•
Power source or inside hybrid vehicle
control ECU
Hybrid vehicle control ECU branch wire
and connector
WIRING DIAGRAM
J/C2
Hybrid Vehicle Control ECU
CANL
CANH
IGCT
MAIN
P/I
+B1
HEV
+B2
MREL
GND1
GND2
CA
C126019E02
CA–26
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR DISCONNECTION (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
BRANCH WIRE)
(a) Disconnect the H14 hybrid vehicle control ECU
connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
CANH
H14
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
H14-8 (CANH) - H14-9
(CANL)
Power switch OFF
54 to 69 Ω
NG
CANL
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
BRANCH WIRE AND CONNECTOR (CANH,
CANL)
C126168E01
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - BATTERY AND BODY
GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the H16 hybrid vehicle control ECU
connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
+B1
+B2
GND1
H16
GND2 H14
C126169E01
CA
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
H14-1 (GND1) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
H14-4 (GND2) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
(c) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
H16-7 (+B1) - Body
ground
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
H16-6 (+B2) - Body
ground
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
NG
OK
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
CA–27
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
Skid Control ECU Communication Stop Mode
DESCRIPTION
Detection Item
Symptom
Trouble Area
SKID CONTROL ECU COMMUNICATION
STOP MODE
•
•
•
•
ABS/VSC/TRAC is not displayed on "BUS
CHECK" screen intelligent tester.
Applies to "SKID CONTROL ECU
COMMUNICATION STOP MODE" in
"DTC COMBINATION TABLE".
Power source or inside skid control ECU
Skid control ECU branch wire and
connector
WIRING DIAGRAM
Skid Control ECU
J/C1
CANL
CANH
IGN
IG2
IG1
ECU-IG
DC/DC
IG1
P/I
IG2
AM2
MAIN
from
Power Source
Control ECU
GND
GND2
GND3
GND4
GND5
CA
GND6
C126170E06
CA–28
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR DISCONNECTION (SKID CONTROL ECU BRANCH WIRE)
(a) Disconnect the S8 skid control ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
S8-19 (CANH) - S8-18
(CANL)
Power switch OFF
54 to 69 Ω
NG
CANH
S8
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU BRANCH
WIRE AND CONNECTOR (CANH, CANL)
CANL
C126171E04
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SKID CONTROL ECU - BATTERY AND BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the S7, S9 and S10 skid control ECU
connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
GND2 GND3
GND
S7
IG1
S8
GND5
GND4
S9
GND6
IG2
S10
C126172E01
CA
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S7-1 (GND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
S8-1 (GND3) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
S8-2 (GND2) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
S9-1 (GND5) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
S9-2 (GND4) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
S10-4 (GND6) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
(c) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
S8-7 (IG1) - Body
ground
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
S10-5 (IG2) - Body
ground
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CA–29
OK
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
CA
CA–30
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
Power Steering ECU Communication Stop Mode
DESCRIPTION
Detection Item
Symptom
Trouble Area
POWER STEERING ECU
COMMUNICATION STOP MODE
•
•
•
EPS is not displayed on "BUS CHECK"
screen of intelligent tester.
Applies to "POWER STEERING ECU
COMMUNICATION STOP MODE" in
"DTC COMBINATION TABLE".
•
Power source or inside power steering
ECU
Power steering ECU branch wire and
connector
WIRING DIAGRAM
Power Steering ECU
J/C1
CANL
CANH
IG1
MAIN
DC/DC
ECU-IG
IG
from
Power Source
Control ECU
PGND
CA
C124540E24
CA–31
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR DISCONNECTION (POWER STEERING ECU BRANCH WIRE)
(a) Disconnect the P8 power steering ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
P8-1 (CANH) - P8-7
(CANL)
Power switch OFF
54 to 69 Ω
NG
CANH
REPLACE POWER STEERING ECU BRANCH
WIRE AND CONNECTOR (CANH, CANL)
CANL
P8
C126173E01
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (POWER STEERING ECU - BATTERY AND BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the P7 power steering ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
P7
PGND
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
P7-2 (PGND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
(c) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
P8
IG
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
P8-6 (IG) - Body ground
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
C126174E01
OK
REPLACE POWER STEERING ECU
CA
CA–32
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
Gateway ECU Communication Stop Mode
DESCRIPTION
Detection Item
Symptom
Trouble Area
GATEWAY ECU COMMUNICATION STOP
MODE
•
•
•
•
BODY / GATEWAY is not displayed on
"BUS CHECK" screen of intelligent tester.
Applies to "GATEWAY ECU
COMMUNICATION STOP MODE" in
"DTC COMBINATION TABLE".
Power source or inside gateway ECU
Gateway ECU branch wire and connector
WIRING DIAGRAM
Gateway ECU
J/C2
CA1L
CA1H
ECU-IG
IG
ECU-B
BATT
ACC
ACC-B
ACC
ACC
IG1
from
Power Source
Control ECU
MAIN
DC/DC
GND
CA
C126175E06
CA–33
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR DISCONNECTION (GATEWAY ECU BRANCH WIRE)
(a) Disconnect the G1 gateway ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
G1
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
G1-17 (CA1H) - G1-18
(CA1L)
Power switch OFF
54 to 69 Ω
NG
REPLACE GATEWAY ECU BRANCH WIRE
AND CONNECTOR (CA1H, CA1L)
CA1H
CA1L
C126176E03
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (GATEWAY ECU - BATTERY AND BODY GROUND)
(a) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
G1
Specified Condition
G1-24 (GND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
IG
BATT
GND
Tester Connection
ACC
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
G1-10 (BATT) - Body
ground
Always
10 to 14 V
G1-2 (ACC) - Body
ground
Power switch ON (ACC)
10 to 14 V
G1-1 (IG) - Body ground
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
C126176E04
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE GATEWAY ECU
CA
CA–34
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
Steering Angle Sensor Communication Stop Mode
DESCRIPTION
Detection Item
Symptom
Trouble Area
STEERING ANGLE SENSOR
COMMUNICATION STOP MODE
•
•
•
STEERING SENSOR is not displayed on
"BUS CHECK" screen of intelligent tester.
Applies to "STEERING ANGLE SENSOR
COMMUNICATION STOP MODE" in
"DTC COMBINATION TABLE".
•
Power source or inside steering angle
sensor
Steering angle sensor branch wire and
connector
NOTICE:
This detection item is not applicable to a vehicle without enhanced VSC.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Steering Angle Sensor
J/C1
CANL
CANH
IG1
MAIN
DC/DC
ECU-IG
IG
from
Power Source
Control ECU
ESS
CA
C124540E25
CA–35
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR DISCONNECTION (STEERING ANGLE SENSOR BRANCH
WIRE)
(a) Disconnect the S13 steering angle sensor connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
S13-10 (CANH) - S3-9
(CANL)
Power switch OFF
54 to 69 Ω
NG
CANH
REPLACE STEERING ANGLE SENSOR
BRANCH WIRE AND CONNECTOR (CANH,
CANL)
S13
CANL
C126177E01
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (STEERING ANGLE SENSOR - BATTERY AND BODY GROUND)
(a) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S13-2 (ESS) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
S13
ESS
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
S13-1 (IG) - Body
ground
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
NG
IG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
C126177E02
OK
REPLACE STEERING ANGLE SENSOR
CA
CA–36
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
Yaw Rate Sensor Communication Stop Mode
DESCRIPTION
Detection Item
Symptom
Trouble Area
YAW RATE SENSOR COMMUNICATION
STOP MODE
•
•
•
•
YAW / DECELERAT is not displayed on
"BUS CHECK" screen of intelligent tester.
Applies to "YAW RATE SENSOR
COMMUNICATION STOP MODE" in
"DTC COMBINATION TABLE".
Power source or inside yaw rate sensor
Yaw rate sensor branch wire and
connector
NOTICE:
This detection item is not applicable to a vehicle without enhanced VSC.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Yaw Rate Sensor
J/C2
CANH
CANL
IG1
MAIN
DC/DC
ECU-IG
IG
from
Power Source
Control ECU
GND
CA
C124540E26
CA–37
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR DISCONNECTION (YAW RATE SENSOR BRANCH WIRE)
(a) Disconnect the Y1 yaw rate sensor connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
Y1-2 (CANL) - Y1-3
(CANH)
Power switch OFF
54 to 69 Ω
NG
Y1
CANL
REPLACE YAW RATE SENSOR BRANCH
WIRE AND CONNECTOR (CANH, CANL)
CANH
F100900E01
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (YAW RATE SENSOR - BATTERY AND BODY GROUND)
(a) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Y1-1 (GND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Y1
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
Y1-5 (IG)- Body ground
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
NG
GND
IG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
F100900E02
OK
REPLACE YAW RATE SENSOR
CA
CA–38
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
ECM Communication Stop Mode
DESCRIPTION
Detection Item
Symptom
Trouble Area
ECM COMMUNICATION STOP MODE
•
Power source or inside ECM
•
ENGINE is not displayed on "BUS
CHECK" screen of intelligent tester.
Applies to "ECM COMMUNICATION
STOP MODE" in "DTC COMBINATION
TABLE".
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
EFI M
EFI
+B
MREL
P/I
E1
E03
ME01
MAIN
E01
E02
E04
C126178E02
CA
CA–39
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ECM - BATTERY AND BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the E4, E5, E6 and E7 ECM connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
E04
E01
E02
E4
+B
ME01
E5
E1
E7
E03
E6
C126179E01
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E4-1 (E04) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
E4-6 (E02) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
E4-7 (E01) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
E5-3 (ME01) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
E5-28 (E1) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
E6-7 (E03) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
(c) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
E7-4 (+B) - Body ground
Power switch OFF
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE ECM
CA
CA–40
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
Battery ECU Communication Stop Mode
DESCRIPTION
Detection Item
Symptom
Trouble Area
BATTERY ECU COMMUNICATION STOP
MODE
•
Power source or inside battery ECU
•
HV BATTERY is not displayed on "BUS
CHECK" screen of intelligent tester.
Applies to "BATTERY ECU
COMMUNICATION STOP MODE" in
"DTC COMBINATION TABLE".
WIRING DIAGRAM
Battery ECU
IG2
AM2
IGN
IG2
from
Power Source
Control ECU
IGCT
HEV
IGCT
from
Hybrid Vehicle
Control ECU
P/I
AM
MAIN
GND
C126180E06
CA
CA–41
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (BATTERY ECU - BATTERY AND BODY GROUND)
(a) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
B11-12 (GND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
IGCT
GND
AM
IG2
B11
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
B11-1 (AM) - Body
ground
Always
10 to 14 V
B11-2 (IGCT) - Body
ground
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
B11-13 (IG2) - Body
ground
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
C126181E01
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE BATTERY ECU
CA
CA–42
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CAN Bus Line
DESCRIPTION
When any DTC for the CAN communication system is output, first measure the resistance between the
terminals of the DLC3 to specify the trouble area, and check that there is not a short in the CAN main wire,
between the CAN bus lines, to +B, or to GND.
WIRING DIAGRAM
H14
Hybrid Vehicle Control ECU
CANL
CANH
E6
ECM
J18
JUNCTION CONNECTOR (J/C2)
9
11
10
30
8
22
21
31
Y1
Yaw Rate Sensor*
CANL
CANH
CANL
CANH
8
9
18
3
19
20
17
CANH
CA1L
CA1H
J15
JUNCTION CONNECTOR (J/C1)
18
11
6
7
19
22
17
18
P8
Power Steering ECU
B11
Battery ECU
CANL
CANH
G1
Gateway ECU
2
S8
Skid Control ECU
CANL
19
8
18
19
7
7
18
1
CANL
CANH
*: w/ enhanced VSC
CA
C126182E04
CA–43
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
J15
JUNCTION CONNECTOR (J/C1)
D1
DLC3
CANL
S13
Steering Angle Sensor*
14
10
9
9
6
21
20
10
CANH
CG
BAT
CANL
CANH
4
16
OBD
DC/DC
MAIN
*: w/ enhanced VSC
C126183E02
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CAN BUS LINE (MAIN WIRE FOR OPEN, BUS LINES FOR SHORT CIRCUIT)
D1
(a) Measure the resistance of the DLC3.
Standard resistance
CANH
CANL
H100769E13
Tester
Connection
Condition
Specified
Condition
Proceed to
D1-6 (CANH) D1-14 (CANL)
Power switch
OFF
54 to 69 Ω
OK
D1-6 (CANH) D1-14 (CANL)
Power switch
OFF
69 Ω or more
NG-A
D1-6 (CANH) D1-14 (CANL)
Power switch
OFF
54 Ω or less
NG-B
NG-A
CHECK CAN MAIN WIRE FOR OPEN
NG-B
CHECK CAN BUS LINES FOR SHORT
CIRCUIT
CA
CA–44
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
OK
2
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B
D1
CANL
(a) Measure the resistance of the DLC3.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
D1-6 (CANH) - D1-16
(BAT)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
D1-14 (CANL) - D1-16
(BAT)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
NG
BAT
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B
H100769E14
OK
3
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND
CG
D1
(a) Measure the resistance of the DLC3.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
D1-4 (CG) - D1-6 (CANH)
Power switch OFF
1 kΩ or more
D1-4 (CG) - D1-14
(CANL)
Power switch OFF
1 kΩ or more
NG
CANL
H100769E15
OK
HOW TO PROCEED WITH TROUBLESHOOTING
CA
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND
CA–45
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
Open in CAN Main Wire
DESCRIPTION
There may be an open circuit in the CAN main wire and / or the DLC3 branch wire when the resistance
between terminals 6 (CANH) and 14 (CANL) of the DLC3 is 69 Ω or more.
Symptom
Trouble Area
Resistance between terminals 6 (CANH) and 14 (CANL) of the DLC3
is 69 Ω or more.
•
•
•
•
•
•
CAN main wire and connector
J/C1 (Junction connector)
J/C2 (Junction connector)
DLC3 branch wire and connector
ECM
Battery ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
B11
Battery ECU
CANL
CANH
D1
DLC3
J15
JUNCTION CONNECTOR (J/C1)
19
8
10
14
18
19
21
6
6
17
7
18
CANL
CANH
J18
JUNCTION CONNECTOR (J/C2)
E6
ECM
10
CANL
CANH
21
30
31
C126184E04
CA
CA–46
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DLC3
D1
(a) Measure the resistance of the DLC3.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester
Connection
Condition
Specified
Condition
Proceed to
D1-6 (CANH) D1-14 (CANL)
Power switch
OFF
108 to 132 Ω
A
D1-6 (CANH) D1-14 (CANL)
Power switch
OFF
132 Ω or more
B
NOTICE:
When the measured value is 132 Ω or more and the
CAN communication system DTC is output, there
may be a fault besides disconnection of the DLC3
branch wire. For that reason, troubleshooting should
be performed again from "HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING" (see page CA-6) after
repairing the trouble area.
CANL
H100769E13
B
REPLACE DLC3 BRANCH WIRE AND
CONNECTOR (CANH, CANL)
A
2
CHECK CAN MAIN WIRE FOR DISCONNECTION (BUS CHECK)
(a) Perform "BUS CHECK" using the intelligent tester via the
CAN VIM (see page CA-16).
Result
Result
Proceed to
Only "ENGINE" is not displayed
A
Only "HV BATTERY" is not displayed
B
Other ("ENGINE" and "HV BATTERY" are not displayed)
C
A
CA
B
Go to step 4
C
Go to step 5
CA–47
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
3
CHECK CAN MAIN WIRE FOR DISCONNECTION (ECM - J/C2)
(a) Disconnect the E6 ECM connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
E6-31 (CANH) - E6-30
(CANL)
Power switch OFF
108 to 132 Ω
NG
REPLACE CAN MAIN WIRE AND
CONNECTOR (ECM - J/C2)
CANH
E6
CANL
C127794E03
OK
REPLACE ECM
4
CHECK CAN MAIN WIRE FOR DISCONNECTION (BATTERY ECU - J/C1)
(a) Disconnect the B11 battery ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
B11
CANL
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
B11-18 (CANH) - B11-19
(CANL)
Power switch OFF
108 to 132 Ω
NG
REPLACE CAN MAIN WIRE AND
CONNECTOR (BATTERY ECU - J/C1)
CANH
C126181E03
OK
CA
REPLACE BATTERY ECU
CA–48
5
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK CAN MAIN WIRE FOR DISCONNECTION (J/C1 - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the J15 J/C1 connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
J15-17 (CANH) - J15-6
(CANL)
Power switch OFF
108 to 132 Ω
NG
Go to step 8
CANL
J15
CANH
C127797E01
OK
6
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the J15 J/C1 connector.
NEXT
7
CHECK CAN MAIN WIRE FOR DISCONNECTION (BATTERY ECU - J/C1)
(a) Disconnect the B11 battery ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
B11
CA
CANL
CANH
C126181E03
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
B11-18 (CANH) - B11-19
(CANL)
Power switch OFF
108 to 132 Ω
NG
REPLACE CAN MAIN WIRE AND
CONNECTOR (BATTERY ECU - J/C1)
CA–49
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
OK
REPLACE BATTERY ECU
8
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the J15 J/C1 connector.
NEXT
9
CHECK CAN MAIN WIRE FOR DISCONNECTION (J/C2 - J/C1)
(a) Disconnect the J18 J/C2 connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
J18-18 (CANH) - J18-7
(CANL)
Power switch OFF
108 to 132 Ω
NG
CANL
REPLACE CAN MAIN WIRE AND
CONNECTOR (J/C2 - J/C1)
J18
CANH
C127797E02
OK
10
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the J18 J/C2 connector.
NEXT
CA
CA–50
11
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK CAN MAIN WIRE FOR DISCONNECTION (ECM - J/C2)
(a) Disconnect the E6 ECM connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
E6-31 (CANH) - E6-30
(CANL)
Power switch OFF
108 to 132 Ω
NG
CANH
CANL
E6
C127794E03
OK
REPLACE ECM
CA
REPLACE CAN MAIN WIRE AND
CONNECTOR
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CA–51
Short in CAN Bus Lines
DESCRIPTION
There may be a short circuit between the CAN bus lines when the resistance between terminals 6 (CANH)
and 14 (CANL) of the DLC3 is below 54 Ω.
Symptom
Trouble Area
Resistance between terminals 6 (CANH) and 14 (CANL) of the DLC3
is below 54 Ω.
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Short between CAN bus lines
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
Battery ECU
ECM
Skid control ECU
Steering angle sensor
Yaw rate sensor
Power steering ECU
Gateway ECU
J/C1 (Junction connector)
J/C2 (Junction connector)
CA
CA–52
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
J18
JUNCTION CONNECTOR (J/C2)
H14
Hybrid Vehicle Control ECU
9
CANL
CANH
8
E6
ECM
11
10
30
22
21
31
CANL
G1
Gateway ECU
Y1
Yaw Rate Sensor*
2
8
9
18
CAN1L
CANL
3
19
CANH
S8
Skid Control ECU
CANL
CANH
20
18
11
6
7
19
22
17
18
19
18
8
7
19
18
7
1
CANL
CANH
S13
Steering Angle Sensor*
D1
DLC3
CANH
CAN1H
P8
Power Steering ECU
CANL
CANL
17
J15
JUNCTION CONNECTOR (J/C1)
B11
Battery ECU
CANH
CANH
14
10
9
6
21
20
9
10
CANL
CANH
*: w/ enhanced VSC
C126185E04
CA
CA–53
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CAN BUS LINES FOR SHORT CIRCUIT (DLC3 BRANCH WIRE)
D1
(a) Disconnect the J15 J/C1 connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the DLC3.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
D1-6 (CANH) - D1-14
(CANL)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
NG
CANL
REPLACE DLC3 BRANCH WIRE AND
CONNECTOR (CANH, CANL)
H100769E13
OK
2
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the J15 J/C1 connector.
NEXT
3
CHECK CAN BUS LINES FOR SHORT CIRCUIT (CAN BUSES TO J/C2)
D1
(a) Disconnect the J18 J/C2 connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the DLC3.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
D1-6 (CANH) - D1-14
(CANL)
Power switch OFF
108 to 132 Ω
OK
Go to step 17
CANL
H100769E13
NG
CA
CA–54
4
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK CAN BUS LINES FOR SHORT CIRCUIT (J/C1 - J/C2)
(a) Disconnect the J15 J/C1 connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
J15-17 (CANH) - J15-6
(CANL)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
HINT:
Measure the resistance with the J18 J/C2 connector
disconnected.
CANL
NG
REPLACE CAN MAIN WIRE AND
CONNECTOR (J/C1 - J/C2)
J15
CANH
C127797E01
OK
5
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the J15 J/C1 connector and J18 J/C2
connector.
NEXT
6
CHECK CAN BUS LINES FOR SHORT CIRCUIT (BATTERY ECU)
D1
(a) Disconnect the B11 battery ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the DLC3.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
D1-6 (CANH) - D1-14
(CANL)
Power switch OFF
108 to 132 Ω
OK
CA
CANL
H100769E13
NG
REPLACE BATTERY ECU
CA–55
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
7
CHECK CAN BUS LINES FOR SHORT CIRCUIT (BATTERY ECU - J/C1)
(a) Disconnect the J15 J/C1 connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
B11
CANL
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
B11-18 (CANH) - B11-19
(CANL)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
HINT:
Measure the resistance with the B11 battery ECU
connector disconnected.
NG
CANH
REPLACE CAN MAIN WIRE AND
CONNECTOR (BATTERY ECU - J/C1)
C126181E03
OK
8
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the B11 battery ECU connector and J15 J/C1
connector.
NEXT
9
CHECK CAN BUS LINES FOR SHORT CIRCUIT (POWER STEERING ECU)
D1
(a) Disconnect the P8 power steering ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the DLC3.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
D1-6 (CANH) - D1-14
(CANL)
Power switch OFF
54 to 69 Ω
OK
REPLACE POWER STEERING ECU
CANL
H100769E13
NG
CA
CA–56
10
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK CAN BUS LINES FOR SHORT CIRCUIT (POWER STEERING ECU BRANCH WIRE)
(a) Disconnect the J15 J/C1 connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
CANH
P8
CANL
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
P8-1 (CANH) - P8-7
(CANL)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
HINT:
Measure the resistance with the P8 power steering ECU
connector disconnected.
NG
REPLACE POWER STEERING ECU BRANCH
WIRE AND CONNECTOR (CANH, CANL)
C126173E01
OK
11
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the P8 power steering ECU connector and
J15 J/C1 connector.
NEXT
12
CHECK CAN BUS LINES FOR SHORT CIRCUIT (STEERING ANGLE SENSOR)
D1
NOTICE:
For vehicles without enhanced VSC, go to "CHECK CAN
BUS LINES FOR SHORT CIRCUIT (SKID CONTROL
ECU)".
(a) Disconnect the S13 steering angle sensor connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the DLC3.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
D1-6 (CANH) - D1-14
(CANL)
Power switch OFF
54 to 69 Ω
OK
CANL
H100769E13
CA
NG
REPLACE STEERING ANGLE SENSOR
CA–57
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
13
CHECK CAN BUS LINES FOR SHORT CIRCUIT (STEERING ANGLE SENSOR BRANCH
WIRE)
(a) Disconnect the J15 J/C1 connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
S13-10 (CANH) - S13-9
(CANL)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
HINT:
Measure the resistance with the S13 steering angle
sensor connector disconnected.
CANH
NG
S13
CANL
REPLACE STEERING ANGLE SENSOR
BRANCH WIRE AND CONNECTOR (CANH,
CANL)
C126177E01
OK
14
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the S13 steering angle sensor connector and
J15 J/C1 connector.
NEXT
15
CHECK CAN BUS LINES FOR SHORT CIRCUIT (SKID CONTROL ECU)
D1
(a) Disconnect the S8 skid control ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the DLC3.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
D1-6 (CANH) - D1-14
(CANL)
Power switch OFF
54 to 69 Ω
OK
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
CANL
H100769E13
NG
CA
CA–58
16
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK CAN BUS LINES FOR SHORT CIRCUIT (SKID CONTROL ECU BRANCH WIRE)
(a) Disconnect the J15 J/C1 connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
CANH
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
S8-19 (CANH) - S8-18
(CANL)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
HINT:
Measure the resistance with the S8 skid control ECU
connector disconnected.
S8
CANL
NG
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU BRANCH
WIRE AND CONNECTOR
C126171E04
OK
REPLACE JUNCTION CONNECTOR (J/C1)
17
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the J18 J/C2 connector.
NEXT
18
CHECK CAN BUS LINES FOR SHORT CIRCUIT (ECM)
D1
(a) Disconnect the E6 ECM connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the DLC3.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
D1-6 (CANH) - D1-14
(CANL)
Power switch OFF
108 to 132 Ω
OK
CANL
H100769E13
CA
NG
REPLACE ECM
CA–59
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
19
CHECK CAN BUS LINES FOR SHORT CIRCUIT (ECM - J/C2)
(a) Disconnect the J18 J/C2 connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
E6-31 (CANH) - E6-30
(CANL)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
HINT:
Measure the resistance with the E6 ECM connector
disconnected.
NG
CANH
CANL
E6
REPLACE CAN MAIN WIRE AND
CONNECTOR (ECM - J/C2)
C127794E03
OK
20
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the E6 ECM connector and J18 J/C2
connector.
NEXT
21
CHECK CAN BUS LINES FOR SHORT CIRCUIT (YAW RATE SENSOR)
D1
NOTICE:
For vehicles without enhanced VSC, go to "CHECK CAN
BUS LINES FOR SHORT CIRCUIT (HYBRID VEHICLE
CONTROL ECU)".
(a) Disconnect the Y1 yaw rate sensor connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the DLC3.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
D1-6 (CANH) - D1-14
(CANL)
Power switch OFF
54 to 69 Ω
OK
REPLACE YAW RATE SENSOR
CANL
H100769E13
NG
CA
CA–60
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
22
CHECK CAN BUS LINES FOR SHORT CIRCUIT (YAW RATE SENSOR BRANCH WIRE)
(a) Disconnect the J18 J/C2 connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
Y1-3 (CANH) - Y1-2
(CANL)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
HINT:
Measure the resistance with the Y1 yaw rate sensor
connector disconnected.
Y1
NG
CANL
CANH
REPLACE YAW RATE SENSOR BRANCH
WIRE AND CONNECTOR (CANH, CANL)
F100900E01
OK
23
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the Y1 yaw rate sensor connector and J18 J/
C2 connector.
NEXT
24
CHECK CAN BUS LINES FOR SHORT CIRCUIT (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU)
D1
(a) Disconnect the H14 hybrid vehicle control ECU
connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the DLC3.
Standard resistance
CANH
H100769E13
CA
Condition
Specified Condition
D1-6 (CANH) - D1-14
(CANL)
Power switch OFF
54 to 69 Ω
OK
CANL
NG
Tester Connection
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
CA–61
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
25
CHECK CAN BUS LINES FOR SHORT CIRCUIT (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
BRANCH WIRE)
(a) Disconnect the J18 J/C2 connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
CANH
H14
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
H14-8 (CANH) - H14-9
(CANL)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
HINT:
Measure the resistance with the H14 hybrid vehicle
control ECU connector disconnected.
CANL
NG
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
BRANCH WIRE AND CONNECTOR (CANH,
CANL)
C126168E01
OK
26
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the H14 hybrid vehicle control ECU
connector and J18 J/C2 connector.
NEXT
27
CHECK CAN BUS LINES FOR SHORT CIRCUIT (GATEWAY ECU)
D1
(a) Disconnect the G1 gateway ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the DLC3.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
D1-6 (CANH) - D1-14
(CANL)
Power switch OFF
54 to 69 Ω
OK
REPLACE GATEWAY ECU
CANL
H100769E13
NG
CA
CA–62
28
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK CAN BUS LINES FOR SHORT CIRCUIT (GATEWAY ECU BRANCH WIRE)
(a) Disconnect the J18 J/C2 connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
G1
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
G1-17 (CA1H) - G1-18
(CA1L)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
HINT:
Measure the resistance with the G1 gateway ECU
connector disconnected.
CA1L
CA1H
NG
C126176E03
OK
REPLACE JUNCTION CONNECTOR (J/C2)
CA
REPLACE GATEWAY ECU BRANCH WIRE
AND CONNECTOR (CA1H, CA1L)
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CA–63
Short to B+ in CAN Bus Line
DESCRIPTION
There may be a short circuit between the CAN bus line and +B when there is resistance between
terminals 6 (CANH) and 16 (BAT) or terminals 14 (CANL) and 16 (BAT) of the DLC3.
Symptom
Trouble Area
There is resistance between terminals 6 (CANH) and 16 (BAT) or
terminals 14 (CANL) and 16 (BAT) of the DLC3.
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Short to +B
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
Battery ECU
ECM
Skid control ECU
Steering angle sensor
Yaw rate sensor
Power steering ECU
CA
CA–64
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
J18
JUNCTION CONNECTOR (J/C2)
Hybrid Vehicle Control ECU
9
CANL H14
8
CANH H14
6
BATT H15
11
10
22
21
from
Battery
from
Battery
CANH
8
9
18
19
20
17
2
3
18
Skid Control ECU
11
6
22
17
from
Battery
from
Battery
CANH
19
8
7
18
19
18
from
Battery
10
BATT
7
P8
1
P8
1
P7
14
10
9
9
6
21
20
10
16
BAT
CA1L
CANL
CANH
BATT
S13
Steering Angle Sensor*
CANH
CA
BATT
Power Steering ECU
D1
DLC3
CANL
CANH
J15
JUNCTION CONNECTOR (J/C1)
B11
Battery ECU
CANL
CANL
CA1H
7
18
CANL S8
19
CANH S8
3
+BI1 S8
5
+BI2 S9
30
E6
31
E6
6
E7
G1
Gateway ECU
Y1
Yaw Rate Sensor*
CANL
ECM
from
Battery
from
Battery
3
CANL
CANH
BAT
*: w/ enhanced VSC
C126186E04
CA–65
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B (DLC3 BRANCH WIRE)
D1
CANL
(a) Disconnect the J15 J/C1 connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the DLC3.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
D1-6 (CANH) - D1-16
(BAT)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
D1-14 (CANL) - D1-16
(BAT)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
BAT
H100769E14
NG
REPLACE DLC3 BRANCH WIRE AND
CONNECTOR (CANH, CANL)
OK
2
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the J15 J/C1 connector.
NEXT
3
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B (CAN BUSES TO J/C2)
D1
CANL
(a) Disconnect the J18 J/C2 connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the DLC3.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
D1-6 (CANH) - D1-16
(BAT)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
D1-14 (CANL) - D1-16
(BAT)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
BAT
H100769E14
OK
Go to step 16
NG
4
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the J18 J/C2 connector.
NEXT
CA
CA–66
5
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B (BATTERY ECU)
(a) Disconnect the B11 battery ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the DLC3.
Standard resistance
CANH
D1
CANL
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
D1-6 (CANH) - D1-16
(BAT)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
D1-14 (CANL) - D1-16
(BAT)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
BAT
H100769E14
OK
REPLACE BATTERY ECU
NG
6
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B (BATTERY ECU - J/C1)
(a) Disconnect the J15 J/C1 connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Battery ECU
B11
CANL
DLC3
CANH
D1
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
B11-18 (CANH) - D1-16
(BAT)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
B11-19 (CANL) - D1-16
(BAT)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
HINT:
Measure the resistance with the B11 battery ECU
connector disconnected.
NG
REPLACE CAN MAIN WIRE AND
CONNECTOR (BATTERY ECU - J/C1)
BAT
C126188E02
OK
7
CA
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the B11 battery ECU connector and J15 J/C1
connector.
NEXT
CA–67
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
8
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B (POWER STEERING ECU)
(a) Disconnect the P8 power steering ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the DLC3.
Standard resistance
CANH
D1
CANL
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
D1-6 (CANH) - D1-16
(BAT)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
D1-14 (CANL) - D1-16
(BAT)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
BAT
H100769E14
OK
REPLACE POWER STEERING ECU
NG
9
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B (POWER STEERING ECU BRANCH WIRE)
(a) Disconnect the J15 J/C1 connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
PIG
P8
Condition
Specified Condition
P8-1 (CANH) - P7-1
(PIG)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
P8-1 (CANL) - P7-1 (PIG)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
HINT:
Measure the resistance with the P8 power steering ECU
connector disconnected.
CANH
P7
Tester Connection
CANL
NG
REPLACE POWER STEERING ECU BRANCH
WIRE AND CONNECTOR (CANH, CANL)
C126173E02
OK
10
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the P8 power steering ECU and J15 J/C1
connector.
NEXT
11
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B (STEERING ANGLE SENSOR)
NOTICE:
For vehicles without enhanced VSC, go to "CHECK CAN
BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B (SKID CONTROL ECU)".
CA
CA–68
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
D1
CANL
(a) Disconnect the S13 steering angle sensor connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the DLC3.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
D1-6 (CANH) - D1-16
(BAT)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
D1-14 (CANL) - D1-16
(BAT)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
BAT
H100769E14
OK
REPLACE STEERING ANGLE SENSOR
NG
12
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B (STEERING ANGLE SENSOR BRANCH WIRE)
(a) Disconnect the J15 J/C1 connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
BAT
CANH
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
S13-10 (CANH) - S13-3
(BAT)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
S13-9 (CANL) - S13-3
(BAT)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
HINT:
Measure the resistance with the S13 steering angle
sensor connector disconnected.
S13
CANL
NG
C126177E03
REPLACE STEERING ANGLE SENSOR
BRANCH WIRE AND CONNECTOR (CANH,
CANL)
OK
13
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the S13 steering angle sensor connector and
J15 J/C1 connector.
NEXT
CA
CA–69
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
14
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B (SKID CONTROL ECU)
(a) Disconnect the A8 skid control ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the DLC3.
Standard resistance
CANH
D1
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
D1-6 (CANH) - D1-16
(BAT)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
D1-14 (CANL) - D1-16
(BAT)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
BAT
CANL
H100769E14
OK
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
NG
15
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B (SKID CONTROL ECU BRANCH WIRE)
(a) Disconnect the J15 J/C1 connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
+BI1
+BI2
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
S8-19 (CANH) - S8-3
(+BI1)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
S8-19 (CANH) - S9-5
(+BI2)
S8-18 (CANL) - S8-3
(+BI1)
S9
CANH
CANL
S8
S8-18 (CANL) - S9-5
(+BI2)
C126171E02
HINT:
Measure the resistance with the S8 skid control ECU
connector disconnected.
NG
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU BRANCH
WIRE AND CONNECTOR (CANH, CANL)
OK
REPLACE CAN MAIN WIRE AND CONNECTOR (J/C1 - J/C2)
16
CONNECT CONNECTOR
CA
(a) Reconnect the J18 J/C2 connector.
NEXT
CA–70
17
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B (ECM)
D1
CANL
(a) Disconnect the E6 ECM connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the DLC3.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
D1-6 (CANH) - D1-16
(BAT)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
D1-14 (CANL) - D1-16
(BAT)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
BAT
H100769E14
OK
REPLACE ECM
NG
18
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B (ECM - J/C2)
(a) Disconnect the J18 J/C2 connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
BATT
Condition
Specified Condition
E6-31 (CANH) - E7-6
(BATT)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
E6-30 (CANL) - E7-6
(BATT)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
HINT:
Measure the resistance with the E6 ECM connector
disconnected.
E7
CANH
CANL
Tester Connection
E6
NG
C127794E01
REPLACE CAN MAIN WIRE AND
CONNECTOR (ECM - J/C2)
OK
19
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the E6 ECM connector and J18 J/C2
connector.
NEXT
CA
20
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B (YAW RATE SENSOR)
NOTICE:
For vehicles without enhanced VSC, go to "CHECK CAN
BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B (HYBRID VEHICLE
CONTROL ECU)".
CA–71
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
D1
CANL
(a) Disconnect the Y1 yaw rate sensor connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the DLC3.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
D1-6 (CANH) - D1-16
(BAT)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
D1-14 (CANL) - D1-16
(BAT)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
BAT
H100769E14
OK
REPLACE YAW RATE SENSOR
NG
21
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B (YAW RATE SENSOR BRANCH WIRE)
(a) Disconnect the J18 J/C2 connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Yaw Rate Sensor
Y1
CANL
DLC3
CANH
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
Y1-3 (CANH) - D1-16
(BAT)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
Y1-2 (CANL) - D1-16
(BAT)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
HINT:
Measure the resistance with the Y1 yaw rate sensor
connector disconnected.
D1
NG
REPLACE YAW RATE SENSOR BRANCH
WIRE AND CONNECTOR
BAT
C127795E04
OK
22
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the Y1 yaw rate sensor connector and J18 J/
C2 connector.
NEXT
CA
CA–72
23
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU)
(a) Disconnect the H14 hybrid vehicle control ECU
connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the DLC3.
Standard resistance
CANH
D1
CANL
BAT
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
D1-6 (CANH) - D1-16
(BAT)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
D1-14 (CANL) - D1-16
(BAT)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
H100769E14
OK
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
NG
24
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU BRANCH
WIRE)
(a) Disconnect the J18 J/C2 connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
BATT
CANH
H15
H14
CANL
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
H14-8 (CANH) - H15-6
(BATT)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
H14-9 (CANL) - H15-6
(BATT)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
HINT:
Measure the resistance with the H14 hybrid vehicle
control ECU connector disconnected.
NG
C126168E02
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
BRANCH WIRE AND CONNECTOR (CANH,
CANL)
OK
25
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the H14 hybrid vehicle control ECU
connector and J18 J/C2 connector.
CA
NEXT
CA–73
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
26
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO +B (GATEWAY ECU)
D1
CANL
(a) Disconnect the G1 gateway ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the DLC3.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
D1-6 (CANH) - D1-16
(BAT)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
D1-14 (CANL) - D1-16
(BAT)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
BAT
H100769E14
OK
REPLACE GATEWAY ECU
NG
REPLACE GATEWAY ECU BRANCH WIRE AND CONNECTOR
CA
CA–74
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
Short to GND in CAN Bus Line
DESCRIPTION
There may be a short circuit between the CAN bus line and GND when there is resistance between
terminals 6 (CANH) and 4 (CG) or terminals 14 (CANL) and 4 (CG) of the DLC3.
CA
Symptom
Trouble Area
There is resistance between terminals 6 (CANH) and 4 (CG) or
terminals 14 (CANL) and 4 (CG) of the DLC3.
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Short to GND
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
Battery ECU
ECM
Skid control ECU
Steering angle sensor
Yaw rate sensor
Power steering ECU
CA–75
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
H14
Hybrid Vehicle Control ECU
CANL
CANH
GND1
GND2
J18
JUNCTION CONNECTOR (J/C2)
9
11
10
30
E6
CANL
8
22
21
31
E6
CANH
7
E6
E03
3
E5
ME01
7
E4
E01
6
E4
E02
1
E4
E04
1
4
Y1
Yaw Rate Sensor*
CANL
CANH
GND
ECM
2
8
9
3
19
20
1
18
7
17
6
Skid Control ECU
CANL
18
S8
11
CANH
19
S8
22
17
GND
1
S7
24
GND2
2
S8
GND3
1
S8
GND4
2
S9
GND5
1
S9
4
GND6 S10
G1
Gateway ECU
18
CA1L
CA1H
GND
J15
JUNCTION CONNECTOR (J/C1)
*: w/ enhanced VSC
C126189E10
CA
CA–76
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
J15
JUNCTION CONNECTOR (J/C1)
B11
Battery ECU
Power Steering ECU
19
8
7
19
18
CANL
CANH
GND
18
7
12
14
CANL
CG
CANL
1
P8
CANH
2
P7
PGND
S13
Steering Angle Sensor*
D1
DLC3
CANH
P8
6
10
9
9
21
20
10
4
2
CANL
CANH
ESS
*: w/ enhanced VSC
C126190E05
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND (DLC3 BRANCH WIRE)
CG
CA
D1
(a) Disconnect the J15 J/C1 connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the DLC3.
Standard resistance
CANH
CANL
Condition
Specified Condition
D1-6 (CANH) - D1-4 (CG)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
D1-14 (CANL) - D1-4
(CG)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
NG
H100769E15
OK
Tester Connection
REPLACE DLC3 BRANCH WIRE AND
CONNECTOR (CANH, CANL)
CA–77
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
2
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the J15 J/C1 connector.
NEXT
3
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND (CAN BUSES TO J/C2)
CG
D1
(a) Disconnect the J18 J/C2 connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the DLC3.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester Connection
CANL
Condition
Specified Condition
D1-6 (CANH) - D1-4 (CG)
Power switch OFF
1 kΩ or more
D1-14 (CANL) - D1-4
(CG)
Power switch OFF
1 kΩ or more
OK
Go to step 16
H100769E15
NG
4
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the J18 J/C2 connector.
NEXT
5
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND (BATTERY ECU)
CG
D1
(a) Disconnect the B11 battery ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the DLC3.
Standard resistance
CANH
CANL
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
D1-6 (CANH) - D1-4 (CG)
Power switch OFF
1 kΩ or more
D1-14 (CANL) - D1-4
(CG)
Power switch OFF
1 kΩ or more
OK
H100769E15
REPLACE BATTERY ECU
NG
CA
CA–78
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
6
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND (BATTERY ECU - J/C1)
(a) Disconnect the J15 J/C1 connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
B11
GND
CANL
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
B11-18 (CANH) - B11-12
(GND)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
B11-19 (CANL) - B11-12
(GND)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
HINT:
Measure the resistance with the B11 battery ECU
connector disconnected.
CANH
NG
C126181E02
REPLACE CAN MAIN WIRE AND
CONNECTOR (BATTERY ECU - J/C1)
OK
7
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the B11 battery ECU connector and J15 J/C1
connector.
NEXT
8
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND (POWER STEERING ECU)
CG
D1
(a) Disconnect the P8 power steering ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the DLC3.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester Connection
CANL
NG
CA
Specified Condition
D1-6 (CANH) - D1-4 (CG)
Power switch OFF
1 kΩ or more
D1-14 (CANL) - D1-4
(CG)
Power switch OFF
1 kΩ or more
OK
H100769E15
Condition
REPLACE POWER STEERING ECU
CA–79
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
9
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND (POWER STEERING ECU BRANCH WIRE)
(a) Disconnect the J15 J/C1 connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
PGND
CANH
P7
P8
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
P8-1 (CANH) - P7-2
(PGND)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
P8-7 (CANL) - P7-2
(PGND)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
HINT:
Measure the resistance with the P8 power steering ECU
connector disconnected.
CANL
NG
C126173E03
REPLACE POWER STEERING ECU BRANCH
WIRE AND CONNECTOR (CANH, CANL)
OK
10
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the P8 power steering ECU connector and
J15 J/C1 connector.
NEXT
11
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND (STEERING ANGLE SENSOR)
CG
D1
NOTICE:
For vehicles without enhanced VSC, go to "CHECK CAN
BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND (SKID CONTROL ECU)".
(a) Disconnect the S13 steering angle sensor connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the DLC3.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester Connection
CANL
Specified Condition
D1-6 (CANH) - D1-4 (CG)
Power switch OFF
1 kΩ or more
D1-14 (CANL) - D1-4
(CG)
Power switch OFF
1 kΩ or more
OK
H100769E15
NG
Condition
REPLACE STEERING ANGLE SENSOR
CA
CA–80
12
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND (STEERING ANGLE SENSOR BRANCH
WIRE)
(a) Disconnect the J15 J/C1 connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
ESS
CANH
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
S13-10 (CANH) - S13-2
(ESS)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
S13-9 (CANL) - S13-2
(ESS)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
HINT:
Measure the resistance with the S13 steering angle
sensor connector disconnected.
S13
CANL
NG
C126177E04
REPLACE STEERING ANGLE SENSOR
BRANCH WIRE AND CONNECTOR (CANH,
CANL)
OK
13
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the S13 steering angle sensor connector and
J15 J/C1 connector.
NEXT
14
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND (SKID CONTROL ECU)
CG
D1
(a) Disconnect the S8 skid control ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the DLC3.
Standard resistance
CANH
CANL
CA
Condition
Specified Condition
D1-6 (CANH) - D1-4 (CG)
Power switch OFF
1 kΩ or more
D1-14 (CANL) - D1-4
(CG)
Power switch OFF
1 kΩ or more
OK
H100769E15
NG
Tester Connection
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU
CA–81
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
15
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND (SKID CONTROL ECU BRANCH WIRE)
Wire Harness Side
GND5
GND
GND4
GND6
(a) Disconnect the J15 J/C1 connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
S8-19 (CANH) - S7-1
(GND)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
S8-19 (CANH) - S8-2
(GND2)
S9
CANH
CANL
S8
S10
S8-19 (CANH) - S8-1
(GND3)
S8-19 (CANH) - S9-2
(GND4)
GND3
GND2
S8-19 (CANH) - S9-1
(GND5)
C126171E03
S8-19 (CANH) - S10-4
(GND6)
S8-18 (CANL) - S7-1
(GND)
S8-18 (CANL) - S8-2
(GND2)
S8-18 (CANL) - S8-1
(GND3)
S8-18 (CANL) - S9-2
(GND4)
S8-18 (CANL) - S9-1
(GND5)
S8-18 (CANL) - S10-4
(GND6)
HINT:
Measure the resistance with the S8 skid control ECU
connector disconnected.
NG
REPLACE SKID CONTROL ECU BRANCH
WIRE AND CONNECTOR (CANH, CANL)
OK
REPLACE CAN MAIN WIRE AND CONNECTOR (J/C1 - J/C2)
16
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the J18 J/C2 connector.
NEXT
CA
CA–82
17
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND (ECM)
CG
(a) Disconnect the E6 ECM connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the DLC3.
Standard resistance
CANH
D1
CANL
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
D1-6 (CANH) - D1-4 (CG)
Power switch OFF
1 kΩ or more
D1-14 (CANL) - D1-4
(CG)
Power switch OFF
1 kΩ or more
OK
H100769E15
REPLACE ECM
NG
18
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND (ECM - J/C2)
(a) Disconnect the J18 J/C2 connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
E01
E02
E04
ME01
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
E6-31 (CANH) - E4-7
(E01)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
E6-31 (CANH) - E4-6
(E02)
E6-31 (CANH) - E6-7
(E03)
E4
E5
E03
CANH
E6
E6-31 (CANH) - E4-1
(E04)
E6-31 (CANH) - E5-3
(ME01)
CANL
C127794E04
E6-30 (CANL) - E4-7
(E01)
E6-30 (CANL) - E4-6
(E02)
E6-30 (CANL) - E6-7
(E03)
E6-30 (CANL) - E4-1
(E04)
E6-30 (CANL) - E5-3
(ME01)
HINT:
Measure the resistance with the E6 ECM connector
disconnected.
CA
NG
OK
REPLACE CAN MAIN WIRE AND
CONNECTOR (ECM - J/C2)
CA–83
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
19
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the E6 ECM connector and J18 J/C2
connector.
NEXT
20
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND (YAW RATE SENSOR)
CG
D1
NOTICE:
For vehicles without enhanced VSC, go to "CHECK CAN
BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND (HYBRID VEHICLE
CONTROL ECU)".
(a) Disconnect the Y1 yaw rate sensor connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the DLC3.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester Connection
CANL
Condition
Specified Condition
D1-6 (CANH) - D1-4 (CG)
Power switch OFF
1 kΩ or more
D1-14 (CANL) - D1-4
(CG)
Power switch OFF
1 kΩ or more
OK
H100769E15
REPLACE YAW RATE SENSOR
NG
21
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND (YAW RATE SENSOR BRANCH WIRE)
(a) Disconnect the J18 J/C2 connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Y1
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
Y1-3 (CANH) - Y1-1
(GND)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
Y1-2 (CANL) - Y1-1
(GND)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
HINT:
Measure the resistance with the Y1 yaw rate sensor
connector disconnected.
GND
CANL
NG
CANH
F100900E03
REPLACE YAW RATE SENSOR BRANCH
WIRE AND CONNECTOR (CANH, CANL)
CA
OK
22
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the Y1 yaw rate sensor connector and J18 J/
C2 connector.
CA–84
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
NEXT
23
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU)
CG
D1
(a) Disconnect the H14 hybrid vehicle control ECU
connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the DLC3.
Standard resistance
CANH
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
D1-6 (CANH) - D1-4 (CG)
Power switch OFF
1 kΩ or more
D11-14 (CANL) - D1-4
(CG)
Power switch OFF
1 kΩ or more
CANL
H100769E15
OK
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
NG
24
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
BRANCH WIRE)
Wire Harness Side
GND2
GND1
(a) Disconnect the J18 J/C2 connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
H14-8 (CANH) - H14-1
(GND1)
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or more
H14-8 (CANH) - H14-4
(GND2)
H14
14-9 (CANL) - H14-1
(GND1)
CANH
CANL
C126168E03
14-9 (CANL) - H14-4
(GND2)
HINT:
Measure the resistance with the H14 hybrid vehicle
control ECU connector disconnected.
NG
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
BRANCH WIRE AND CONNECTOR (CANH,
CANL)
OK
CA
25
CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Reconnect the H14 hybrid vehicle control ECU
connector and J18 J/C2 connector.
NEXT
CA–85
CAN COMMUNICATION – CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
26
CHECK CAN BUS LINE FOR SHORT TO GND (GATEWAY ECU)
CG
D1
(a) Disconnect the G1 gateway ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the DLC3.
Standard resistance
CANH
CANL
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
D1-6 (CANH) - D1-4 (CG)
Power switch OFF
1 kΩ or more
D1-14 (CANL) - D1-4
(CG)
Power switch OFF
1 kΩ or more
OK
H100769E15
REPLACE GATEWAY ECU
NG
REPLACE GATEWAY ECU BRANCH WIRE AND CONNECTOR (CA1H, CA1L)
CA
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
CC–1
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
1.
NOTICE FOR INITIALIZATION
NOTICE:
When the cable of the negative (-) battery terminal is
disconnected, initialize the following system(s) after
the cable is reconnected.
System Name
See procedure
Power Window Control System
IN-32
2.
3.
NOTICE FOR HYBRID SYSTEM ACTIVATION
NOTICE:
• When the warning light is illuminated or the
battery has been disconnected and reconnected,
pressing the power switch may not start the
system on the first try. If so, press the power
switch again.
• With the power switch's power mode changed to
ON (IG), disconnect the battery. If the key is not in
the key slot during reconnection, DTC B2799 may
be output.
NOTICE FOR CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
NOTICE:
Push the cruise control main switch ON-OFF button
"off" and reset the cruise control if the CRUISE main
indicator light blinks while driving with cruise
control. When the cruise control cannot be set by
this procedure or canceled immediately after setting,
there may be a problem in the cruise control system.
Do not inspect the cruise control system under the
following road conditions:
• Heavy traffic
• Steep downhill
• Sharp turns
• Icy or snowy roads
• Slippery roads
CC
CC–2
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
THROTTLE BODY
- THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
- THROTTLE MOTOR
INVERTER
CC
HYBRID VEHICLE
CONTROL ECU
GATEWAY ECU
COMBINATION METER
SKID CONTROL
ECU
SHIFT POSITION
SENSOR
CRUISE CONTROL MAIN SWITCH
STOP LIGHT
SWITCH
SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSEMBLY
DLC3
ACCELERATOR PEDAL
POSITION SENSOR
B140276E01
CC–3
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
Cruise Control Main Switch
Stop Light Switch
Inverter
Hybrid Vehicle
Control ECU
Combination Meter
CC
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor
Throttle Position
Sensor and Motor
Shift Position Sensor
CAN Communication Line
Skid Control ECU
ECM
Gateway ECU
BEAN
Combination Meter
I102162E01
Communication method
Transmitting ECU
Receiver
Hybrid Vehicle Control ECU
ECM
Engine torque demand signal
CAN
Combination Meter
•
•
•
•
Hybrid Vehicle Control ECU
Cruise control cancel signal
Skid Control ECU
Signals
CRUISE main indicator signal
Cruise control warning signal
Communication Method
CAN
BEAN
CAN
CC–4
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
2.
CC
3.
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The cruise control system controls constant speed
driving. It enables the driver to adjust vehicle speed by
operating the cruise control main switch without using
the accelerator pedal.
Receiving signals from each switch and sensor, the
hybrid vehicle control ECU controls constant speed
driving by optimizing the use of the engine and motor
driving force.
LIMIT CONTROL
(a) Low speed limit
The lowest possible limit of the speed setting range
is approximately 40 km/h (25 mph). The cruise
control system cannot be set when the driving
speed is below the low speed limit. Constant speed
control will be automatically canceled and the stored
vehicle speed will be erased when the vehicle
speed goes below the low speed limit while the
constant speed control is in operation.
(b) High speed limit
The highest possible limit of the speed setting range
is approximately 180 km/h (112 mph). The cruise
control system cannot be set when the driving
speed is over the high speed limit. Speed up using
RESUME/+ with the cruise control main switch
assembly also cannot be set beyond the high speed
limit.
CRUISE CONTROL OPERATION
(a) Cruise control main switch
The cruise control main switch operates 7 functions:
SET, COAST, TAP-DOWN, RESUME, ACCEL,
TAP-UP, and CANCEL. The SET, TAP-DOWN and
COAST functions, and the RESUME, TAP-UP and
ACCEL functions share the same switch. Each
function can be controlled by moving the switch in
the directions of the arrows on the cruise control
main switch assembly. The switch will return
automatically after it is released.
(b) Set control
Vehicle speed is stored and constant speed control
is maintained when pushing the switch to -/SET
while driving with the cruise control main switch ONOFF button "on" (CRUISE main indicator light is on),
and the vehicle speed is within the set speed range
(between the low and high speed limits).
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
CC–5
(c) Coast control
The hybrid vehicle control ECU decreases the
cruise control demand speed and controls the
engine and motor driving force to decelerate the
vehicle when -/SET on the cruise control main
switch is pressed and held while the cruise control
system is in operation. Vehicle speed, when the
cruise control main switch is released from -/SET, is
stored and constant speed control is maintained.
(d) Tap-down control
When tapping down on the cruise control main
switch to -/SET (for approx. 0.5 seconds) while the
cruise control system is in operation, the stored
vehicle speed decreases each time by
approximately 1.6 km/h (1.0 mph).
However, when the difference between the driving
and the stored vehicle speed is more than 5 km/h
(3.1 mph) and the cruise control main switch is
released from -/SET, the vehicle speed will be
stored and constant speed control is maintained.
(e) Acceleration control
The hybrid vehicle control ECU increases the cruise
control demand speed and controls the engine and
motor driving force to accelerate the vehicle when +/
RES on the cruise control main switch is pressed
and held while the cruise control system is in
operation.
Vehicle speed, when the cruise control main switch
is released from +/RES, is stored and constant
speed control is maintained.
(f) Tap-up control
When tapping up on the cruise control main switch
to +/RES (for approx. 0.5 seconds) while the cruise
control system is in operation, the stored vehicle
speed increases each time by approximately 1.6
km/h (1.0 mph). However, when the difference
between the driving and the stored vehicle speed is
more than 5 km/h (3.1 mph), the stored vehicle
speed will not be changed.
(g) Resume control
If constant speed control was canceled with the stop
light switch or the CANCEL switch, and if driving
speed is within the limit range, pushing the cruise
control main switch to -/RES restores vehicle speed
memorized at the time of cancellation, and restarts
constant speed control.
(h) Manual cancel control
Doing any of the following cancels the cruise control
system while in operation. (The stored vehicle
speed in the hybrid vehicle ECU is maintained).
• Depressing the brake pedal
• Shifting into any position except D
• Pushing the cruise control main switch to
CANCEL
CC
CC–6
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
(i)
CC
• Pushing the cruise control main switch ON-OFF
button "off" (The stored vehicle speed in the
hybrid vehicle control ECU is not maintained).
Auto cancel (fail-safe)
This system has an automatic cancellation function
(fail-safe) (see page CC-12).
CC–7
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
• Use these procedures to troubleshoot the cruise control
system.
• *: Use the intelligent tester.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
CC
2
INSPECT BATTERY VOLTAGE
Standard voltage:
11 to 14 V
If the voltage is below 11 V, recharge or replace the battery
before proceeding.
NEXT
3
CHECK INDICATOR LIGHT
NEXT
4
CHECK DTC*
(a) Check for DTCs and note any codes that are output.
(b) Delete the DTC.
(c) Recheck for DTCs, and try to prompt the DTC by
simulating the original activity that the DTC suggests.
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC does not reoccur
A
DTC reoccurs
B
B
Go to step 7
A
5
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Result
Result
Proceed to
Fault is not listed in problem symptoms table
A
Fault is listed in problem symptoms table
B
B
Go to step 7
CC–8
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
A
6
OVERALL ANALYSIS AND TROUBLESHOOTING*
(a) Terminals of ECU (see page CC-9)
(b) DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST (see page CC-13)
NEXT
7
CC
REPAIR OR REPLACE
NEXT
8
CONFIRMATION TEST
NEXT
END
ROAD TEST
1.
I102366
I102367
PROBLEM SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION
(a) Inspect the SET function.
(1) Push the ON-OFF button "on".
(2) Drive at the required speed (40 km/h (25 mph)
or higher).
(3) Push the cruise control main switch to -/SET.
(4) Check that the vehicle cruises at the set speed
after releasing the switch.
(b) Inspect the "+ (ACCEL)" function.
(1) Push the ON-OFF button "on".
(2) Drive at the required speed (40 km/h (25 mph)
or higher).
(3) Push the cruise control main switch to -/SET.
(4) Check that vehicle speed increases while the
cruise control main switch is pushed to +/RES,
and that the vehicle cruises at the newly set
speed when the switch is released.
(5) Momentarily push the cruise control main switch
to +/RES and then immediately release it. Check
that vehicle speed increases by approximately
1.6 km/h (1.0 mph) (tap-up function).
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
I102366
I102368
I102367
CC–9
(c) Inspect the "- (COAST)" function.
(1) Push the ON-OFF button "on".
(2) Drive at the required speed (40 km/h (25 mph)
or higher).
(3) Push the cruise control main switch to -/SET.
(4) Check that vehicle speed decreases while the
cruise control main switch is pushed to -/SET,
and that the vehicle cruises at the newly set
speed when the switch is released.
(5) Momentarily push the cruise control main switch
to -/SET and then immediately release it. Check
that vehicle speed decreases by approximately
1.6 km/h (1.0 mph) (tap-down function).
(d) Inspect the CANCEL function.
(1) Push the ON-OFF button "on".
(2) Drive at the required speed (40 km/h (25 mph)
or higher).
(3) Push the cruise control main switch to -/SET.
(4) When doing one or more of the following, check
that the cruise control system is canceled and
that the normal driving mode is reset:
• Depressing the brake pedal
• Shifting into any position except D
• Pushing the ON-OFF button "off"
• Pulling the cruise control main switch to
CANCEL
(e) Inspect the RES (RESUME) function.
(1) Push the ON-OFF button "on".
(2) Drive at the required speed (40 km/h (25 mph)
or higher).
(3) Push the cruise control main switch to -/SET.
(4) When doing one or more of the following, check
that the cruise control system is canceled and
that the normal driving mode is reset:
• Depressing the brake pedal
• Shifting into any position except D
• Pulling the cruise control main switch to
CANCEL
(5) After pushing the cruise control main switch to +/
RES at a driving speed of more than 40 km/h (25
mph), check that the vehicle restores the speed
which was maintained before cancellation.
CC
CC–10
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
• Use the table below to help determine the cause of the
problem symptom. The potential causes of the symptoms
are listed in order of probability in the "Suspected area"
column of the table. Check each symptom by checking the
suspected areas in the order they are listed. Replace parts
as necessary.
• Insect the fuses and relays related to this system before
inspecting the suspected areas below.
Cruise control system
Symptom
CC
Suspected area
1. Cruise control switch circuit
ON-OFF button cannot be pushed on (CRUISE main
indicator light on combination meter does not come on)
Vehicle speed cannot be set (indicator light on
combination meter comes on when ON-OFF button is
pushed on, but it goes off when vehicle speed is set)
Setting cannot be done (indicator light on combination
meter come on when ON-OFF button is pushed on,
and it remains on while setting)
Cruise control is canceled while driving (CRUISE main
indicator light remains on)
Hunting occurs (speed is not constant)
Setting cannot be canceled (when functions such as
COAST, ACCEL, RESUME, set speed change are
operated with control switch)
See page
CC-23
2. Cruise main indicator light circuit
CC-29
3. Combination meter
-
4. Hybrid vehicle control ECU
-
1. Cruise control switch circuit
CC-23
2. Hybrid vehicle control ECU
-
1. Cruise control switch circuit
CC-23
2. Stop light switch circuit
CC-19
3. Shift position sensor circuit
HV-102
4. Combination meter
-
5. Hybrid vehicle control ECU
-
1. Cruise control switch circuit
CC-23
2. Vehicle speed sensor circuit
CC-15
3. Stop light switch circuit
CC-19
4. Cruise main indicator light circuit
CC-29
5. Hybrid vehicle control ECU
-
1. Vehicle speed sensor circuit
CC-15
2. Hybrid vehicle control ECU
-
1. Cruise control switch circuit
CC-23
2. Hybrid vehicle control ECU
-
CC–11
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
H17
CHECK HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
H15
H16
H14
I039285E01
(a) Measure the voltage of the connectors.
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
ST1 (H15-2) - GND1
(H14-1)
G - W-B
Stop light signal
Power switch is ON (IG),
depress brake pedal
Below 1 V
Power switch is ON (IG),
release brake pedal
10 to 14 V
Power switch is ON (IG),
depress brake pedal
10 to 14 V
Power switch is ON (IG),
release brake pedal
Below 1 V
Power switch is ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
Power switch is ON (IG),
CANCEL switch is held on
6.6 to 10.1 V
Power switch is ON (IG),
-/SET switch is held on
4.5 to 7.1 V
Power switch is ON (IG),
+/RES switch is held on
2.3 to 4.0 V
Power switch is ON (IG),
ON-OFF button is pushed
on
Below 1 V
Power switch is ON (IG),
slowly turn wheel
Below 1 V to above 5 V
STP (H15-3) - GND1
(H14-1)
CCS (H14-13) - GND1
(H14-1)
SPDI (H14-19) - GND1
(H14-1)
L - W-B
V - W-B
Cruise control main switch
circuit
Vehicle speed input signal
If the result is not as specified, the ECU may have a
malfunction.
CC
CC–12
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
CC
1.
DESCRIPTION
The ECU controls the function of cruise control on this
vehicle. Data of the cruise control or DTC can be read
from DLC3 of the vehicle. When a trouble occurs with
cruise control, check that the CRUISE main indicator
light does not come on but DTC inspection is performed.
Therefore when there seems to be a problem with the
cruise control, use the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM)
or SST to check and troubleshoot it.
2.
CHECK DLC3
The hybrid vehicle control ECU of the vehicle uses ISO
15765-4 for communication. The terminal arrangement
of the DLC3 complies with SAE J1962 and matches the
ISO 15765-4 format.
CG SG CANH SIL
CANL
BAT
H100769E16
Symbols (Terminal No. 1)
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified condition
SIL (7) - SG (5)
Bus "+" line
During transmission
Pulse generation
CG (4) - Body ground
Chassis ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
SG (5) - Body ground
Signal ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
BAT (16) - Body ground
Battery positive
Always
11 to 14 V
CANH (6) - CANL (14)
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Power switch is OFF*
54 to 67 Ω
CANH (6) - Battery positive
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Power switch is OFF*
1 MΩ or higher
CANH (6) - CG (4)
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Power switch is OFF*
3 MΩ or higher
CANL (14) - Battery positive
LOW-level CAN bus line
Power switch is OFF*
1 MΩ or higher
CANL (14) - CG (4)
LOW-level CAN bus line
Power switch is OFF*
3 MΩ or higher
NOTICE:
*: Before measuring the resistance, leave the vehicle
as is for at least 1 minute and do not operate the
power switch, other switches or doors.
If the result is not as specified, the DLC3 may have a
malfunction. Repair or replace the harness and
connector.
HINT:
Connect the cable of the intelligent tester (with CAN
VIM) to the DLC3, turn the power switch ON (IG) and
attempt to use the tester. If the display indicates that a
communication error has occurred, there is a problem
either with the vehicle or with the tester.
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
CC–13
• If communication is normal when the tester is
connected to another vehicle, inspect the DLC3 of the
original vehicle.
• If communication is still not possible when the tester
is connected to another vehicle, the problem may be
in the tester itself. Consult the Service Department
listed in the tester's instruction manual.
Intelligent Tester
CAN VIM
DLC3
CC
A082795E04
3.
I039302E01
CHECK INDICATOR
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Check that the CRUISE main indicator light comes
on when the cruise control main switch ON-OFF
button is pushed on, and that the indicator light goes
off when the ON-OFF button is pushed off.
HINT:
• If there is a problem with the indicator light,
inspect the CRUISE main indicator light circuit
(see page CC-29).
• If a malfunction occurs in the vehicle speed
sensor, stop light switch or other related parts
while driving with cruise control, and the hybrid
vehicle control ECU activates AUTO CANCEL of
the cruise control and then the CRUISE main
indicator light starts to blink, informing the driver
of the malfunction. At the same time, data of the
malfunction is stored as a DTC.
DTC CHECK / CLEAR
1.
Intelligent Tester
CAN VIM
DLC3
2.
A082795E04
CHECK DTC
(a) Using the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM), check
for DTCs.
(1) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to
the DLC3.
(2) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(3) Read the DTCs by following the prompts on the
tester screen.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual
for further details.
CLEAR DTC
(a) Using the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM), clear the
DTCs.
(1) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to
the DLC3.
(2) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
CC–14
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
(3) Erase the DTCs by following the directions on
the tester screen.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual
for further details.
CC
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
CC–15
FAIL-SAFE CHART
1.
FAIL-SAFE CHART
If the following conditions are detected while the cruise
control is in operation, the system clears the stored
vehicle speed in the hybrid vehicle control ECU and
cancels the cruise control operation.
Cruise control system
Vehicle Condition
Auto Cancel Condition
Re-operation Condition
CRUISE main indicator light blinks
When either condition below is met:
• There is an open or short in stop light
switch circuit
• Vehicle speed signal changes suddenly
Push cruise control main switch ON-OFF
button "on" again
CRUISE main indicator light blinks
There is a problem with input circuit of stop
light switch circuit
When either condition below is met:
• Indicator light blinks until cruise control
main switch ON-OFF button is pushed on
again
• Constant speed control is prohibited until
the power switch is turned OFF
CRUISE main indicator light turns off
When either condition below is met:
• Vehicle speed is below the low speed limit
(approx. 40 km/h (approx. 25 mph)) while
driving with cruise control on
• Vehicle speed is lower than stored speed
by approx. 16 km/h (approx. 9.9 mph) or
more while driving with cruise control on
Push cruise control main switch to -/RES
CC
CC–16
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST
1.
CC
READ DATA LIST
HINT:
Using the intelligent tester's DATA LIST allows switch,
actuator and other item values to be read without
removing any parts. Reading the Data List early in
troubleshooting is one way to save time.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Read the DATA LIST according to the display on the
tester.
Hybrid vehicle control system
Item
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
VEHICLE SPD
Cruise control vehicle speed/
min.: 0 km/h (0 mph), max.: 255
km/h (158 mph)
Actual vehicle speed is displayed
-
MEMORY SPD
Cruise control memorized speed/
min.: 1 km/h (0.6 mph), max.: 255
km/h (158 mph)
Actual vehicle speed is displayed
-
THROTTLE
Request opening angle/ min.: 0%,
max.: 125%
Actual throttle opening angle is
displayed
-
CRUISE CTRL
Cruise control system active
condition/ON or OFF
ON: Cruise control is activated
OFF: Cruise control is
deactivated
-
MAIN SW (MAIN)
CRUISE main switch signal (Main
CPU)/ON or OFF
ON: Cruise control main switch
ON-OFF button is pushed on
OFF: Cruise control main switch
ON-OFF button is pushed off
"3"
MAIN SW (SUB)
CRUISE main switch signal (Sub
CPU)/ON or OFF
ON: Cruise control main switch
ON-OFF button is pushed on
OFF: Cruise control main switch
ON-OFF button is pushed off
"3"
CCS READY M
Cruise control system standby
condition (Main CPU)/ON or OFF
ON ←→ OFF: Switching each
time ON-OFF button is pushed
"1"
CCS READY S
Cruise control system standby
condition (Sub CPU)/ON or OFF
ON ←→ OFF: Switching each
time ON-OFF button is pushed
"1"
CCS INDICATOR M
Cruise indicator signal (Main
CPU)/ON or OFF
ON: CRUISE main indicator light
is on
OFF: CRUISE main indicator light
is off
"2"
CCS INDICATOR S
Cruise indicator signal (Sub
CPU)/ON or OFF
ON: CRUISE main indicator light
is on
OFF: CRUISE main indicator light
is off
"2"
CANCEL SW
CANCEL switch signal/ON or
OFF
ON: Cruise control main switch is
pulled to CANCEL
OFF: Cruise control main switch
is not pulled to CANCEL
-
SET/COAST SW
-/SET switch signal/ON or OFF
ON: Cruise control main switch is
pushed to -/SET
OFF: Cruise control main switch
is not pushed to -/SET
-
RES/ACC SW
+/RES switch signal/ON or OFF
ON: Cruise control main switch is
pushed to +/RES
OFF: Cruise control main switch
is not pushed to +/RES
-
STP LIGHT SW1 M
Stop light switch signal (Main
CPU)/ON or OFF
ON: Brake pedal is depressed
OFF: Brake pedal is released
-
CC–17
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Item
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
STP LIGHT SW2 S
Stop light switch signal (Sub
CPU)/ON or OFF
ON: Brake pedal is depressed
OFF: Brake pedal is released
-
STP LIGHT SW1 S
Stop light switch signal (Sub
CPU)/ON or OFF
ON: Brake pedal is depressed
OFF: Brake pedal is released
-
SHIFT D POS
Shift lever position sensor signal
(D position)/ON or OFF
ON: Shift position is D
OFF: Shift position is not D
-
VEHICLE SPD CHG
Vehicle speed sudden change/
ON or OFF
ON: Changed
OFF: Not changing
-
HINT:
"3" is OK but "1" is NG → Hybrid vehicle control
ECU failure
"1" is OK but "2" is NG → DTC output or hybrid
vehicle control ECU failure
"3" is OK but the CRUISE main indicator light does
not turn on → CRUISE main indicator light , wire
harness, or hybrid vehicle control ECU failure
CC
CC–18
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
HINT:
If a malfunction code is displayed during the DTC check,
check the circuit indicated by the DTC. For details of each
code, refer to the respective "DTC No." in the DTC chart.
Cruise control system
DTC No.
CC
Detection Item
Trouble Area
See page
P0500
Vehicle Speed Sensor "A"
- Vehicle speed sensor
- Vehicle speed sensor circuit
- Combination meter
- Hybrid vehicle control ECU
CC-15
P0571
Brake Switch "A" Circuit
- Stop light switch
- Stop light switch circuit
- Hybrid vehicle control ECU
CC-19
P0607
Control Module Performance
- Hybrid vehicle control ECU
CC-22
HINT:
DTC P0607 indicates an internal abnormality of the hybrid
vehicle control ECU. If this DTC is output, replace the hybrid
vehicle control ECU.
CC–19
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0500
Vehicle Speed Sensor "A"
DESCRIPTION
The speed sensor for the skid control ECU detects wheel speed and sends appropriate signals to the skid
control ECU.
The skid control ECU converts these wheel speed signals into 4-pulse signals and outputs them to the
hybrid vehicle control ECU via the combination meter.
The hybrid vehicle control ECU determines vehicle speed based on the frequency of these pulse signals.
CC
4-Pulse
From
Speed Sensor
4-Pulse
Hybrid Vehicle
Control ECU
Skid Control
ECU
Combination Meter
I102164E01
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0500
This trouble code is output when a signal from
vehicle speed sensor is cut for 1.4 seconds or
more while cruise control is in operation
•
•
•
•
Vehicle speed sensor
Vehicle speed sensor circuit
Combination meter
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
Combination Meter
Hybrid Vehicle Control ECU
SPDI
E115290E15
CC–20
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK OPERATION OF SPEEDOMETER
(a) Drive the vehicle and check if the function of the
speedometer in the combination meter is normal.
OK:
Actual vehicle speed and the speed indicated on
the speedometer are the same.
HINT:
The vehicle speed sensor is functioning normally when
the indication on the speedometer is normal.
CC
NG
GO TO SPEEDOMETER CIRCUIT
OK
2
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (VEHICLE SPEED SIGNAL)
(a) Check the DATA LIST for proper functioning of the
vehicle speed signal.
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
VEHICLE SPD
Cruise control vehicle speed/
min.: 0 km/h (0 mph), max.: 255
km/h (158 mph)
Actual vehicle speed is
displayed
-
OK:
The speed displayed on the tester screen is almost the
same as the speed the one indicated on the
combination meter.
OK
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
3
INSPECT HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU (SPD VOLTAGE)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
H14
SPDI
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Move the shift lever to neutral.
Jack up the vehicle.
Measure the voltage of the connector.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
SPDI (H14-19) - Body ground
Waveform appears
HINT:
The output voltage fluctuates up and down, similarly to
the diagram on the left, when the wheel is turned slowly.
OK
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
4.5 to
5.5 V
0V
Turn Wheel
I102399E01
NG
4
CC–21
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ECU - METER)
(a) Disconnect the H14 ECU connector.
(b) Disconnect the C10 meter connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
ECM
E14
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
SPDI (H14-19) - C10-13
Below 1 Ω
NG
SPDI
Combination Meter
C10
I102400E01
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
CC
CC–22
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
OK
REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
CC
CC–23
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0571
Brake Switch "A" Circuit
DESCRIPTION
When the brake pedal is depressed, the stop light switch sends a signal to the hybrid vehicle control ECU.
Receiving the signal, the hybrid vehicle control ECU cancels the cruise control. Even if there is a
malfunction in the stop light signal circuit while the cruise control is in operation, normal driving is
maintained due to fail-safe function.
Cruise control is canceled when positive battery voltage is applied to terminal STP.
When the brake pedal is depressed, positive voltage is applied to terminal STP of the hybrid vehicle
control ECU through the STOP fuse and the stop light switch, and the hybrid vehicle control ECU cancels
the cruise control.
When the brake pedal is released, positive voltage is applied to terminal ST1- of the hybrid vehicle control
ECU through the IGN fuse and the stop light switch, and the hybrid vehicle control ECU operates the
cruise control.
HINT:
Inspect the fuses and relays before confirming the suspected areas which are shown in the table below.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0571
Trouble code is output when voltages of
terminals ST1- and STP of the hybrid vehicle
control ECU are both below 1 V for 0.5
seconds or more
•
•
•
Stop light switch
Stop light switch circuit
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
Hybrid Vehicle Control ECU
Stop Light Switch
DC/DC
STOP
STP
IG2
P/I
MAIN
AM2
IGN
ST1-
to Power Source
Control ECU
E124731E01
CC
CC–24
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT STOP LIGHT SWITCH OPERATION
(a) Check that the stop light turns on when the brake pedal
is depressed, and goes off when the brake pedal is
released.
OK:
The stop light turns on/turns off normally.
HINT:
The stop light uses the circuit on the terminal STP side of the
hybrid vehicle control ECU.
CC
NG
GO TO STOP LIGHT SWITCH CIRCUIT
OK
2
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (STOP LIGHT SWITCH)
(a) Check the DATA LIST for proper functioning of the stop
light switch.
ECM
Item
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
STP LIGHT SW1 M
Stop light switch signal (Main
CPU)/ON or OFF
ON: Brake pedal is depressed
OFF: Brake pedal is released
-
STP LIGHT SW1 S
Stop light switch signal (Sub
CPU)/ON or OFF
ON: Brake pedal is depressed
OFF: Brake pedal is released
-
STP LIGHT SW2 S
Stop light switch signal (Sub
CPU)/ON or OFF
ON: Brake pedal is depressed
OFF: Brake pedal is released
-
OK:
Display changes according to brake pedal
operation described in above table.
OK
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
NG
3
INSPECT STOP LIGHT SWITCH ASSEMBLY
2
1
(a) Remove the stop light switch.
(b) Measure the resistance of the switch.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
3-4
Pushed
Specified Condition
Not pushed
Below 1 Ω
Pushed
10 kΩ or higher
Not Pushed
4
3
I004062E05
OK
Switch Condition
NG
REPLACE STOP LIGHT SWITCH ASSEMBLY
CC–25
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SWITCH - BATTERY)
(a) Disconnect the S16 switch connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
S16
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S16-3 - Body ground
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
CC
E110511E06
OK
5
CHECK HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Wire Harness Side
Reconnect the S16 switch connector.
Disconnect the H15 ECU connector.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Switch Connection
Specified Condition
STP (H15-3) - Body
ground
Brake pedal is
depressed
10 to 14 V
ST1- (H15-2) - Body
ground
H15
NG
STP
ST1I039294E01
OK
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
Brake pedal is released
Below 1 V
Brake pedal is released
10 to 14 V
Brake pedal is
depressed
Below 1 V
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
CC–26
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0607
Control Module Performance
DESCRIPTION
DTC P0607 is stored when an internal abnormality of the hybrid vehicle control ECU is detected.
CC
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0607
Hybrid vehicle control ECU has a supervisory
CPU and a control CPU. Trouble code is
output when input STP signals to each CPU
are different for 0.15 seconds or more.
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
HINT:
If DTC P0607 is detected while the cruise control is in operation, the system clears the stored vehicle
speed in the hybrid vehicle control ECU and cancels the cruise control operation. At the same time, the
CRUISE main indicator light blinks to inform the driver of the malfunction.
When this trouble code is detected, fail-safe remains on until the power switch is turned OFF.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DTC
(a) Clear the DTC (see page CC-12).
(b) Check the DTC (see page CC-12).
OK:
DTC is not output.
NG
OK
END
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
CC–27
Cruise Control Switch Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This circuit sends signals to the ECU depending on the cruise control main switch condition. The battery
supplies positive (+) battery voltage to the cruise control main switch. Then terminal CCS of the ECU
receives the voltage according to the switch condition.
WIRING DIAGRAM
CC
Cruise Control Main Switch
Hybrid Vehicle
Control ECU
Spiral Cable
CCS
CCS
CANCEL
-SET
+RES
ON-OFF
ECC
E110505E02
CC–28
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (CRUISE CONTROL MAIN SWITCH)
(a) Check the DATA LIST for proper functioning of the cruise
control main switch.
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
CC
Item
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
MAIN SW (MAIN)
Cruise control main switch signal
(Main CPU) / ON or OFF
ON: Cruise control main switch
ON-OFF button is pushed on
OFF: Cruise control main switch
ON-OFF button is pushed off
-
MAIN SW (SUB)
Cruise control main switch signal
(Sub CPU) / ON or OFF
ON: Cruise control main switch
ON-OFF button is pushed on
OFF: Cruise control main switch
ON-OFF button is pushed off
-
CANCEL SW
CANCEL switch signal / ON or
OFF
ON: CANCEL switch ON
OFF: CANCEL switch OFF
-
SET/COAST SW
-/SET switch signal / ON or OFF
ON: -/SET switch ON
OFF: -/SET switch OFF
-
RES/ACC Switch
+/RES switch signal / ON or OFF
ON: +/RES switch ON
OFF: +/RES switch OFF
-
OK:
When cruise control main switch operation is
performed, the results will be same as above.
OK
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
NG
2
CHECK HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
(a) Measure the voltage of the connector.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
H14-13 (CCS) - Body
ground
Cruise control main
switch off
10 to 14 V
+/RES
6.6 to 10.1 V
-/SET
4.5 to 7.1 V
CANCEL
2.3 to 4.0 V
Cruise control main
switch on
Below 1 V
H14
OK
CCS
I102360E01
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
CC–29
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
NG
3
INSPECT CRUISE CONTROL MAIN SWITCH
(a) Disconnect the H14 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
H14-13 (CCS) - Body
ground
Neutral
10 kΩ or higher
+/RES
210 to 270 Ω
H14
OK
Specified Condition
-/SET
560 to 700 Ω
CANCEL
1,380 to 1,700 Ω
Cruise control main
switch on
Below 1 Ω
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
CCS
I039293E01
NG
4
INSPECT CRUISE CONTROL MAIN SWITCH
(a) Measure the resistance of the switch.
Standard resistance
+RES
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
1-3
+/RES
210 to 270 Ω
ON-OFF
CANCEL
-SET
NG
I102362E01
-/SET
560 to 700 Ω
CANCEL
1,380 to 1,700 Ω
Cruise control main
switch on
Below 1 Ω
Cruise control main
switch off
10 kΩ or higher
REPLACE CRUISE CONTROL MAIN SWITCH
CC
CC–30
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
OK
5
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
(a) Disconnect the spiral cable connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Spiral Cable Side
A
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A-3 - B-1
Below 1 Ω
A-4 - B-3
CC
NG
Cruise Control Main Switch Side
B
I102363E01
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
6
CC–31
INSPECT SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the spiral cable connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the cable.
Standard resistance
Switch Side
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A-3 - C12-1
Below 1 Ω
A-4 - C12-2
C12
NG
REPLACE SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSEMBLY
CC
ECU Side
I102364E01
OK
CC–32
7
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SPIRAL CABLE - ECU AND BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the C12 cable connector.
(b) Disconnect the H14 ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Spiral Cable
C12
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
C12-1 - H14-13 (CCS)
Below 1 Ω
C12-2 - Body ground
CC
NG
Hybrid Vehicle Control ECU
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
H14
CCS
I102402E01
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
CC–33
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
Cruise Main Indicator Light Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The hybrid vehicle control ECU outputs the cruise control operation status to the CRUISE main indicator
light on the combination meter.
The CRUISE main indicator light circuit uses CAN and BEAN for communication. If there are any
malfunctions in this circuit, check for DTCs in the CAN communication system and the multiplex
communication system.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (CRUISE MAIN INDICATOR LIGHT)
(a) Check the DATA LIST for proper functioning of the
CRUISE main indicator light.
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
CCS INDICATOR M
Cruise indicator signal (Main
CPU) / ON or OFF
ON: CRUISE main indicator is
ON
OFF: CRUISE main indicator is
OFF
-
CCS INDICATOR S
Cruise indicator signal (Sub
CPU) / ON or OFF
ON: CRUISE main indicator is
ON
OFF: CRUISE main indicator is
OFF
-
OK:
Cruise control indicator light illuminates.
Result
Result
Proceed to
OK
A
NG (ON / OFF operates only on tester)
(see page ME-11)
B
NG (ON / OFF does not operate only on tester)
C
B
GO TO METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
C
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
A
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
CC
CC–30
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL MAIN SWITCH
CRUISE CONTROL MAIN SWITCH
CRUISE CONTROL SYSTEM
COMPONENTS
“TORX” SCREW
8.8 (90, 78 in.*lbf)
“TORX” SCREW
8.8 (90, 78 in.*lbf)
CC
CRUISE CONTROL MAIN SWITCH
50 (510, 37)
STEERING WHEEL ASSEMBLY
NO. 2 STEERING WHEEL
COVER LOWER
NO. 3 STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER
STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B131356E01
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL MAIN SWITCH
CC–31
REMOVAL
B078424E02
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE NO. 2 STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER
3.
REMOVE NO. 3 STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER
4.
REMOVE STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY (See page RS268)
5.
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL ASSEMBLY (See page
SR-8)
6.
REMOVE CRUISE CONTROL MAIN SWITCH
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the 2 screws and switch.
CC
CC–32
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL MAIN SWITCH
INSPECTION
1.
+RES
INSPECT CRUISE CONTROL MAIN SWITCH
(a) Measure the resistance of the switch.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
ON-OFF
CANCEL
-SET
1-3
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
+RES
210 to 270 Ω
-SET
560 to 700 Ω
CANCEL
1,380 to 1,700 Ω
ON-OFF button is on
Below 1 Ω
ON-OFF button is off
10 kΩ or higher
If the result is not as specified, replace the switch
assembly.
CC
I102362E01
CRUISE CONTROL – CRUISE CONTROL MAIN SWITCH
CC–33
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL CRUISE CONTROL MAIN SWITCH
(a) Install the switch with the 2 screws.
(b) Connect the connector.
2.
INSTALL STEERING WHEEL ASSEMBLY (See page
SR-15)
3.
INSTALL STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY (See page RS269)
4.
INSTALL NO. 2 STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER
5.
INSTALL NO. 3 STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER
6.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
7.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
8.
CHECK SRS WARNING LIGHT
(a) Check the SRS warning light (see page RS-31).
CC
1NZ-FXE CHARGING – CHARGING SYSTEM
CH–1
CHARGING SYSTEM
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT BATTERY
NOTICE:
If the battery is dead or "READY" does not light up,
recharge the battery. Check the battery again before
the vehicle is returned to the customer.
(a) Check the appearance of the battery.
(1) Check that the battery is not damaged or
deformed.
If damaged or deformed, replace the battery (
the dedicated battery for PRIUS).
CH
CH–2
1NZ-FXE CHARGING – BATTERY
BATTERY
1NZ-FXE CHARGING
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD
REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD
REAR DECK FLOOR BOX
CH
6.0 (61, 53 in.*lbf)
BATTERY NEGATIVE
CABLE
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A124443E06
CH–3
1NZ-FXE CHARGING – BATTERY
CONNECTOR COVER
FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK
CONNECTOR
6.0 (61, 53 in.*lbf)
FUSIBLE LINK
BLOCK ASSEMBLY
5.4 (55, 48 in.*lbf)
5.4 (55, 48 in.*lbf)
BATTERY HOLD DOWN CLAMP
BATTERY
CH
BATTERY ROOM VENTILATION HOSE
4.0 (41, 35 in.*lbf)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
NO. 2 QUARTER VENT DUCT
A127731E01
CH–4
1NZ-FXE CHARGING – BATTERY
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD
(a) Unlock the 2 washer tank cover knobs, and then
remove the rear floor board.
2.
REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX
(a) Remove the rear deck floor box from the vehicle.
3.
REMOVE REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD
(a) Detach the 4 claws, and then remove the floor
board.
4.
DISCONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE CABLE
(a) Loosen the nut, and then disconnect the battery
negative cable (engine wire).
5.
REMOVE CONNECTOR COVER
(a) Detach the 3 claws, and then remove the connector
cover.
A088353E01
A088354E01
CH
A088355E02
A088356E01
A088357E02
1NZ-FXE CHARGING – BATTERY
6.
CH–5
REMOVE NO. 2 QUARTER VENT DUCT
(a) Disconnect the brake control power supply
connector.
(b) Disconnect the 2 fusible link block connectors.
(c) Remove the wire harness from the quarter vent
duct.
A088358E01
(d) Remove the bolt and screw, and then remove the
quarter vent duct.
A088359E01
7.
REMOVE FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a clip remover, remove the clip.
(b) Loosen the nut, and then remove the fusible link
block.
CH
A088360E01
8.
REMOVE BATTERY HOLD DOWN CLAMP
(a) Remove the bolt and nut, and then remove the
battery hold down clamp.
9.
REMOVE BATTERY
(a) Remove the grommet of the battery room ventilation
hose from the vehicle.
(b) Remove the battery from the vehicle.
A088361E01
A088362E01
CH–6
1NZ-FXE CHARGING – BATTERY
(c) Remove the battery room ventilation hose from the
battery.
A088363E01
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL BATTERY
(a) Install the battery room ventilation hose to the
battery.
A088363
(b) Install the battery to the vehicle.
(c) Install the grommet of the battery room ventilation
hose to the vehicle.
CH
A088362E01
2.
INSTALL BATTERY HOLD DOWN CLAMP
(a) Install the battery hold down clamp with the bolt and
nut.
Torque: 5.4 N*m (55 kgf*cm, 48 in.*lbf)
3.
INSTALL FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the fusible link block with the nut and clip, and
then tighten the nut.
Torque: 6.0 N*m (61 kgf*cm, 53 in.*lbf)
A088361E01
A088360E01
1NZ-FXE CHARGING – BATTERY
4.
CH–7
INSTALL NO. 2 QUARTER VENT DUCT
(a) Install the quarter vent duct with the bolt and screw.
Torque: 4.0 N*m (41 kgf*cm, 35 in.*lbf)
(b) Install the wire harness to the quarter vent duct.
A088359E01
(c) Connect the 2 fusible link connectors.
(d) Connect the brake control power supply connector.
A088358E01
A088357E02
5.
INSTALL CONNECTOR COVER
(a) Install the connector cover, and then attach the 3
claws.
6.
CONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE CABLE
NOTICE:
• When the warning light is illuminated or the
battery has been disconnected and reconnected,
turning the power switch may not start the system
on the first try. If so, turn the power switch again.
• With the power switch's power mode changed to
ON (IG), disconnect the battery. If the key is not in
the key slot during reconnection, DTC B2799 may
be output.
(a) Connect the battery negative cable, and then
tighten the nut.
Torque: 6.0 N*m (61 kgf*cm, 53 in.*lbf)
A088356E01
CH
CH–8
1NZ-FXE CHARGING – BATTERY
7.
INSTALL REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD
(a) Install the floor board, and then attach the 4 claws.
8.
INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX
(a) Install the rear deck floor box to the vehicle.
9.
INSTALL REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD
(a) Install the floor board, and then lock the 2 cover
knobs.
A088355E02
A088354E01
10. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
CH
A088353E01
1NZ-FXE COOLING – COOLING SYSTEM
CO–1
COOLING SYSTEM
1NZ-FXE COOLING
ENGINE
PARTS LOCATION
RADIATOR CAP
CO
THERMOSTAT
A124645E01
CO–2
1NZ-FXE COOLING – COOLING SYSTEM
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
CHECK COOLING SYSTEM FOR LEAKS
CAUTION:
Do not remove the radiator cap while the engine and
radiator are still hot. Pressurized, hot engine coolant
and steam may be released and cause serious
burns.
(a) Fill the radiator with coolant and attach a radiator
cap tester.
(b) Warm up the engine.
(c) Using the radiator cap tester, increase the pressure
inside the radiator to 177 kPa (1.8 kgf/cm2, 25.6
psi), and check that the pressure does not drop.
If the pressure drops, check the hoses, radiator and
water pump for leaks. If no external leaks are found,
check the cylinder block and head.
A088171E01
2.
CHECK ENGINE COOLANT LEVEL IN RESERVOIR
(a) The engine coolant should be between the low and
full lines when the engine is cold.
If low, check for leaks and add TOYOTA Super Long
Life Coolant (SLLC) or similar high quality ethylene
glycol based non-silicate, non-amine, non-nitrite,
non-borate coolant with long-life hybrid organic acid
technology up to the full line.
NOTICE:
Never use water as a substitute for engine
coolant.
3.
CHECK ENGINE COOLANT QUALITY
(a) Remove the radiator cap.
CAUTION:
Do not remove the radiator cap while the engine
and radiator are still hot. Pressurized, hot
engine coolant and steam may be released and
cause serious burns.
(b) Check if there are excessive deposits of rust or
scale around the radiator cap and radiator filler hole.
Also, the coolant should be free of oil.
If excessively dirty, replace the coolant.
(c) Install the radiator cap.
CO
CO–3
1NZ-FXE COOLING – COOLING FAN SYSTEM
COOLING FAN SYSTEM
1NZ-FXE COOLING
ENGINE
PARTS LOCATION
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
CO
COOLING FAN MOTOR
ENGINE ROOM RELAY BLOCK, JUNCTION BLOCK
- RDI H-FUSE
- NO. 2 FAN RELAY (Marking: FAN NO. 2)
- CDS FAN FUSE - NO. 3 FAN RELAY (Marking: FAN NO. 3)
- INTEGRATION RELAY (UNIT C: NO. 1 (FAN NO. 1) RELAY)
ECM
A/C AMPLIFIER
A124646E01
CO–4
1NZ-FXE COOLING – COOLING FAN SYSTEM
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
from Battery
from IG
RDI
CO
from Battery
ECU-IG
CDS FAN
NO. 3 FAN
NO. 2 FAN
NO. 1 FAN
Cooling
Fan
Motor
ECM
FAN
A/C Amplifier
RF
CF
Radiator Fan
Motor
Engine
Coolant
Temperature
Sensor
A126792E01
1NZ-FXE COOLING – COOLING FAN SYSTEM
CO–5
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
HINT:
It is normal for the cooling fan to sometimes rotate when the
ignition switch is turned from ACC to ON.
1.
CHECK COOLING FAN OPERATION AT LOW
TEMPERATURE (Below 83°C (181°F))
(a) Turn the ignition switch ON with the A/C switch OFF.
(b) Check that the cooling fan stops.
If it does not, check the cooling fan relay and engine
coolant temperature sensor, and check if there is a
disconnection or circuit open between them.
(c) Disconnect the engine coolant temperature sensor
connector.
(d) Check that the cooling fan rotates.
If it does not, check the fuses, cooling fan relay,
ECM and cooling fan, and check for a short in the
circuit between the cooling fan relay and engine
coolant temperature sensor.
(e) Reconnect the engine coolant temperature sensor
connector.
2.
CHECK COOLING FAN OPERATION AT HIGH
TEMPERATURE (Above 93°C (199°F))
(a) Start the engine, and raise the coolant temperature
to above 93°C (199°F).
HINT:
Coolant temperature is the value detected by the
engine coolant temperature sensor on the cylinder
head.
(b) Check that the A/C switch is OFF.
(c) Check that the cooling fan rotates.
If it does not, check the fuses, cooling fan relay,
ECM, cooling fan and engine coolant temperature
sensor.
3.
CHECK COOLING FAN
(a) Disconnect the cooling fan connector.
(b) Connect the battery and an ammeter to the cooling
fan.
(c) Check that the cooling fan rotates smoothly, and
check the reading on the ammeter.
Standard amperage:
9.2 to 11.0 A
(d) Reconnect the cooling fan connector.
CO
CO–6
1NZ-FXE COOLING – COOLANT
COOLANT
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
CAUTION:
Do not remove the radiator cap while the engine and
radiator are still hot. Pressurized, hot engine coolant and
steam may be released and cause serious burns.
A088174E01
CO
1.
REMOVE RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
(a) Remove the 6 clips and radiator support opening
cover.
2.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
3.
REMOVE FRONT FENDER LINER LH
(a) Remove the front part of the front fender liner LH.
4.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
(a) Disconnect the coolant heat storage water pump
connector.
(b) Connect a vinyl hose to the drain cock of the
radiator.
(c) Connect a vinyl hose to the drain cock of the engine.
(d) Connect a vinyl hose to the drain cock of the coolant
heat storage tank.
CAUTION:
If the tank has any malfunctions, the tank
surface becomes hot. To prevent injuries from
burns, do not touch the tank.
(e) Loosen the drain cock plugs of the radiator, engine
and coolant heat storage tank, then drain the
coolant.
CAUTION:
Even if the engine is cold, the coolant in the
coolant heat storage tank is still hot. Be careful
of the hot coolant when draining it.
HINT:
Record the amount of the drained coolant. It will be
referred to when refilling the tank with coolant.
CO–7
1NZ-FXE COOLING – COOLANT
(f)
Remove the radiator cap.
Radiator Cap
Engine Drain Cock Plug
Drain Cock Plug
Radiator Drain Cock Plug
A124655E01
(g) Drain the coolant in the radiator reservoir.
5.
ADD ENGINE COOLANT
(a) Tighten the drain cock plug of the coolant heat
storage tank, then disconnect the vinyl hose.
(b) Tighten the drain cock plug of the engine, then
disconnect the vinyl hose.
Torque: 13 N*m (133 kgf*cm, 9.6 ft.*lbf)
(c) Tighten the drain cock plug of the radiator, then
disconnect the vinyl hose.
(d) Connect a vinyl hose to the bleeder plug of the
radiator assembly and the radiator reservoir.
HINT:
Insert the vinyl hose inside the radiator reservoir
tank.
Vinyl Hose
A092991E01
A088678E01
(e) Using a 6 mm socket hexagon wrench, loosen the
radiator bleeder plug from the radiator support
service hole.
(f) Fill the radiator with coolant up to the fill port.
Standard capacity:
8.6 liters (9.1 US qts, 7.6 Imp. qts)
HINT:
• When filling coolant, press the radiator hose a
few times. If the coolant level goes down, add
more coolant.
CO
CO–8
1NZ-FXE COOLING – COOLANT
• Amount of coolant to fill: Approximately 2.4 liters
(2.5 US qts, 2.1 Imp. qts)
• Use of improper coolants may damage the
engine cooling system.
• Only use "Toyota Super Long Life Coolant", or
similar high quality ethylene glycol based nonsilicate, non-amine, non-nitrite, and non-borate
coolant with long-life hybrid organic acid
technology.
• New Toyota vehicles are filled with Toyota Super
Long Life Coolant (color is pink, premixed
ethylene-glycol concentration is approximately
50% and freezing temperature is -35°C (-31°F)).
When replacing the coolant, Toyota Super Long
Life Coolant is recommended.
• Observe the coolant level inside the radiator by
pressing the inlet and outlet radiator hoses
several times by hand. If the coolant level goes
down, add more coolant.
NOTICE:
Never use water as a substitute for engine
coolant.
(g) Using a 6 mm socket hexagon wrench, tighten the
radiator bleeder plug.
Torque: 1.5 N*m (15 kgf*cm, 13 in.*lbf)
(h) Install the radiator cop.
(i) Fill the radiator reservoir tank with coolant to the full
level.
(j) Connect the coolant heat storage water pump
connector.
CO
DLC3
A087542E02
A088678E01
(k) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(l) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(m) Select the item:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST /
WATER PUMP
NOTICE:
• The water pump motor operates for 30
seconds after WATER PUMP is ON in the
ACTIVE TEST mode, then it automatically
stops operating.
• Do not actuate the water pump motor without
coolant filled.
(n) Using a 6 mm socket hexagon wrench, loosen the
radiator bleeder plug from the radiator support
service hole.
(o) Remove the radiator cap, then fill the radiator with
coolant up to the fill port.
HINT:
When filling coolant, press the radiator hose a few
times. If the coolant level goes down, add more
coolant.
(p) Using a 6 mm socket hexagon wrench, tighten the
radiator bleeder plug.
Torque: 1.5 N*m (15 kgf*cm, 13 in.*lbf)
1NZ-FXE COOLING – COOLANT
CO–9
(q) Install the radiator cap.
(r) Slowly pour coolant into the radiator reservoir until it
reaches the full line.
(s) Disconnect the vinyl hose between the bleeder plug
of the radiator assembly and the radiator reservoir
tank.
(t) Set the vehicle to inspection mode (see page IN-5).
(u) Warm up the engine until the thermostat is open.
(v) Stop the engine, then wait until the coolant becomes
cold. Remove the radiator cap and check the
coolant level.
CAUTION:
If the engine or radiator is hot, do not remove
the radiator cap.
If the coolant level is lower, add coolant again.
Warm up the engine, then check the coolant level.
(w) When the coolant level stops going down, add
coolant to the radiator reservoir tank up to the full
level.
6.
A088174E01
CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS
(a) Fill the radiator with engine coolant and attach a
radiator cap tester.
(b) Pump the tester to 137 kPa (1.4 kgf/cm2, 19.9 psi)
and check for leakage.
7.
INSTALL FRONT FENDER LINER LH
8.
INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
9.
INSTALL RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
(a) Install the opening cover with the 6 clips.
CO
CO–10
1NZ-FXE COOLING – WATER PUMP
WATER PUMP
1NZ-FXE COOLING
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
GENERATOR V BELT
x6
11 (112, 8)
11 (112, 8)
11 (112, 8)
RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
15 (153, 11)
GASKET
CO
11 (112, 8)
11 (112, 8)
WATER PUMP
PULLEY
WATER PUMP ASSEMBLY
ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A124647E01
1NZ-FXE COOLING – WATER PUMP
CO–11
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
(See page CO-6)
2.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
3.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
4.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-6)
5.
REMOVE GENERATOR V BELT (See page EM-6)
6.
REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR SUBASSEMBLY RH (See page EM-32)
7.
REMOVE WATER PUMP PULLEY
(a) Using SST, hold the pump pulley.
SST 09960-10010 (09962-01000, 09963-00600)
(b) Remove the 3 bolts and pump pulley.
SST
CO
A092654E01
8.
REMOVE WATER PUMP ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 3 bolts and 2 nuts.
(b) Remove the water pump and gasket.
B009338E01
INSPECTION
1.
A037047
INSPECT WATER PUMP ASSEMBLY
(a) Visually check the water hole and air hole for
coolant leakage.
If leakage is found, replace the water pump
assembly.
(b) Turn the pulley, and check that the pump bearing
moves smoothly and quietly.
If it moves roughly or noisily, replace the water
pump assembly.
INSTALLATION
SST
A092654E01
1.
INSTALL WATER PUMP ASSEMBLY
(a) Install a new gasket and the water pump with the 3
bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque: 11 N*m (112 kgf*cm, 8 ft.*lbf)
2.
INSTALL WATER PUMP PULLEY
(a) Using SST, install the pump pulley with the 3 bolts.
SST 09960-10010 (09962-01000, 09963-00600)
Torque: 15 N*m (153 kgf*cm, 11 ft.*lbf)
CO–12
1NZ-FXE COOLING – WATER PUMP
3.
INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR SUBASSEMBLY RH (See page EM-38)
4.
INSTALL GENERATOR V BELT (See page EM-6)
5.
ADJUST GENERATOR V BELT (See page EM-6)
6.
ADD ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-7)
7.
CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS (See page
CO-9)
8.
INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
9.
INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
10. INSTALL RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
(See page CO-9)
CO
1NZ-FXE COOLING – THERMOSTAT
CO–13
THERMOSTAT
1NZ-FXE COOLING
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
x6
RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
CO
ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
A127898E01
CO–14
1NZ-FXE COOLING – THERMOSTAT
O-RING
THERMOSTAT
CO
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
WATER INLET
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A124648E01
1NZ-FXE COOLING – THERMOSTAT
CO–15
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
(See page CO-6)
2.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
3.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
4.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-6)
5.
REMOVE WATER INLET
(a) Remove the 2 nuts and disconnect the water inlet
from the cylinder block.
6.
REMOVE THERMOSTAT
(a) Remove the thermostat.
(b) Remove the gasket from the thermostat.
A086915E01
A088872E01
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT THERMOSTAT
HINT:
The valve opening temperature is inscribed on the
thermostat.
P013560E03
(a) Immerse the thermostat in water and then gradually
heat the water.
(b) Check the valve opening temperature of the
thermostat.
Standard valve opening temperature:
80 to 84°C (176 to 183°F)
If the valve opening temperature is not as specified,
replace the thermostat.
P000436E03
CO
CO–16
1NZ-FXE COOLING – THERMOSTAT
(c) Check the valve lift.
Standard valve lift:
8.5 mm (0.338 in.) or more at 95°C (203°F)
If the valve lift is not as specified, replace the
thermostat.
(d) Check that the valve is fully closed when the
thermostat temperature is below 77°C (171°F).
If not fully closed, replace the thermostat.
8.5 mm
A085445E03
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL THERMOSTAT
(a) Install a new gasket to the thermostat.
A088873E01
CO
10°
(b) Install the thermostat with the jiggle valve facing
upward.
HINT:
The jiggle valve may be set within 10° of either side
as shown in the illustration.
10°
A081900E03
A086915E01
2.
INSTALL WATER INLET
(a) Install the water inlet to the cylinder block with the 2
nuts.
Torque: 9.0 N*m (92 kgf*cm, 80 in.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Ensure that the gasket is not stuck between the
water inlet and cylinder block.
3.
ADD ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-7)
4.
CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS (See page
CO-9)
5.
INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
6.
INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
7.
INSTALL RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
(See page CO-9)
CO–17
1NZ-FXE COOLING – FAN
FAN
1NZ-FXE COOLING
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
x6
Clip
RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
8.5 (87, 75 in.*lbf)
21 (214, 16)
20 (204, 15)
COOLER BRACKET
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
INVERTER
BRACKET
x5
x2
25 (255, 18)
CO
RADIATOR SUPPORT
HOOD LOCK CONTROL CABLE
HOOD LOCK ASSEMBLY
HORN CONNECTOR
FRONT BUMPER COVER
ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A124649E01
CO–18
1NZ-FXE COOLING – FAN
3.9 (40, 35 in.*lbf)
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
3.9 (40, 35 in.*lbf)
FAN WITH MOTOR ASSEMBLY
NO. 2 COOLING FAN MOTOR
COOLING FAN MOTOR
FAN
6.2 (63, 55 in.*lbf)
CO
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
NO. 2 FAN
RADIATOR SUPPORT UPPER LH
NO. 2 INVERTER COOLING HOSE
RADIATOR SUPPORT UPPER RH
WIRE HARNESS
RADIATOR INLET HOSE
FAN MOTOR CONNECTOR
RADIATOR OUTLET HOSE
FAN CONNECTOR
NO. 1 INVERTER COOLING
HOSE
TEMPERATURE SWITCH CONNECTOR
HOSE CLAMP
RADIATOR DRAIN COCK PLUG
NO. 5 INVERTER COOLING HOSE
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
NO. 1 HEAT STORAGE WATER BY-PASS HOSE
A127789E01
1NZ-FXE COOLING – FAN
CO–19
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
2.
REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-4)
3.
REMOVE REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
4.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM BATTERY NEGATIVE
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
5.
REMOVE RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
(See page CO-6)
6.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
7.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
8.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
(a) Drain the coolant in the radiator on the engine side
(see page CO-6).
(b) After draining the coolant in the radiator on the
engine side, remove the radiator drain cock plug.
(c) Drain the coolant in the radiator on the hybrid side
(see page HX-58).
9.
REMOVE FRONT BUMPER COVER (See page ET-4)
10. REMOVE FAN WITH MOTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connector and hose shown in the
illustration.
(b) After disconnecting the hose, remove the hose
clamp.
A086917E01
(c) Disconnect the hose shown in the illustration.
(d) After disconnecting the hose, remove the 2 hose
clamps.
A086918E01
CO
CO–20
1NZ-FXE COOLING – FAN
(e) Disconnect the connector shown in the illustration.
A086919E01
(f)
Disconnect the hose shown in the illustration.
A086920E01
CO
(g) Disconnect the radiator outlet hose.
(h) Disconnect the radiator reservoir hose.
A086921E01
(i)
Disconnect the inverter reservoir hose from the
clamps.
A086922E01
(j) Disconnect the radiator inlet hose.
(k) Disconnect the connector and remove the clamp
shown in the illustration.
A086923E01
1NZ-FXE COOLING – FAN
(l)
CO–21
Remove the 3 bolts and inverter bracket.
A086924E01
(m) Remove the 2 bolts and cooler bracket.
A086925E01
(n) Disconnect the horn connector shown in the
illustration.
A086926E01
(o) Remove the 3 bolts, disconnect the hood lock
control cable, and then remove the hood lock.
A086927E01
(p) Remove the 5 bolts and radiator support.
(q) Remove the hood lock control cable from the
radiator support.
A086928E01
CO
CO–22
1NZ-FXE COOLING – FAN
(r)
Disconnect the wire harness clamps shown in the
illustration.
A086929E01
(s) Remove the 4 bolts, then remove the fan with motor
from the vehicle.
CO
A086930E01
11. REMOVE FAN
(a) Remove the nut and fan.
12. REMOVE NO. 2 FAN
(a) Remove the nut and fan.
13. REMOVE COOLING FAN MOTOR
(a) Remove the 3 bolts and fan motor.
14. REMOVE NO. 2 COOLING FAN MOTOR
(a) Remove the 3 bolts and fan motor.
A128250
INSTALLATION
A128250
1.
INSTALL COOLING FAN MOTOR
(a) Install the fan motor with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 3.9 N*m (40 kgf*cm, 35 in.*lbf)
2.
INSTALL NO. 2 COOLING FAN MOTOR
(a) Install the fan motor with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 3.9 N*m (40 kgf*cm, 35 in.*lbf)
1NZ-FXE COOLING – FAN
CO–23
3.
INSTALL FAN
(a) Install the fan with the nut.
Torque: 6.2 N*m (63 kgf*cm, 55 in.*lbf)
4.
INSTALL NO. 2 FAN
(a) Install the fan with the nut.
Torque: 6.2 N*m (63 kgf*cm, 55 in.*lbf)
5.
INSTALL FAN WITH MOTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Set the fan with motor to the vehicle, then install it
with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (76 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
CO
A086930E01
(b) Connect the 2 wire harness clamps shown in the
illustration.
A086929E01
(c) Install the hood lock control cable to the radiator
support.
(d) Install the radiator support with the 5 bolts.
Torque: 5.0 N*m (51 kgf*cm, 44 in.*lbf)
A086928E01
CO–24
1NZ-FXE COOLING – FAN
(e) Connect the hood lock control cable to the hood
lock.
(f) Install the hood lock with the 3 bolts (see page ED5).
A092969E01
(g) Connect the horn connector shown in the
illustration.
A086926E01
CO
(h) Install the cooler bracket with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 20 N*m (204 kgf*cm, 15 ft.*lbf) for bolt A
Torque: 8.5 N*m (87 kgf*cm, 75 in.*lbf) for bolt B
B
A
A092519E01
(i)
Install the inverter bracket with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 21 N*m (214 kgf*cm, 16 ft.*lbf) for bolt A
Torque: 25 N*m (255 kgf*cm, 18 ft.*lbf) for bolt B
B
B
A
A089867E01
(j) Connect the connector and install the clamp.
(k) Connect the radiator inlet hose.
A086923E01
1NZ-FXE COOLING – FAN
(l)
CO–25
Connect the inverter reservoir hose to each clamp.
A086922E01
(m) Connect the radiator reservoir hose.
(n) Connect the radiator outlet hose.
A086921E01
(o) Connect the hose shown in the illustration.
A086920E01
(p) Connect the connector shown in the illustration.
A086919E01
(q) Install the 2 hose clamps to the fan shroud.
(r) Connect the hose shown in the illustration.
A086918E01
CO
CO–26
1NZ-FXE COOLING – FAN
(s) Install the hose clamp to the fan shroud.
(t) Connect the hose and connector shown in the
illustration.
6.
INSTALL FRONT BUMPER COVER (See page ET-6)
7.
CONNECT CABLE TO BATTERY NEGATIVE
TERMINAL
8.
INSTALL REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
9.
INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-8)
A086917E01
10. INSTALL REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
11. ADD ENGINE COOLANT
(a) Fill the radiator on the hybrid side with coolant (see
page HX-58).
(b) Fill the radiator on the engine side with coolant (see
page CO-7).
CO
12. CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS
(a) Check the cooling system on the hybrid side for
coolant leaks.
(b) Check the cooling system on the engine side for
coolant leaks (see page CO-9).
13. INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
14. INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
15. INSTALL RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
(See page CO-9)
16. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting the cable from the negative (-)
battery terminal.
CO–27
1NZ-FXE COOLING – COOLING FAN RELAY
COOLING FAN RELAY
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY (UNIT C: NO. 1 FAN
(FAN NO. 1) RELAY)
(a) Inspect the resistance of the fan relay.
(1) Measure the resistance between the terminals.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3G-1- 3G-4
10 kΩ or higher
3G-1- 3G-4
Below 1 Ω
(apply battery voltage to terminals
3G-2 and 3G-3)
3G
8 76 5
CO
4 32 1
A129013E01
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the
integration relay.
2.
1
4
2
4
3
5
5
1
2
3
INSPECT NO. 2 FAN RELAY (Marking: FAN NO. 2)
(a) Remove the relay from the engine room relay block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the relay.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-4
Below 1 Ω
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-4
10 kΩ or higher
(when battery voltage is applied to
terminals 1 and 2)
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to
terminals 1 and 2)
A087121E01
If the result is not as specified, replace the relay.
(c) Install the relay.
CO–28
1NZ-FXE COOLING – COOLING FAN RELAY
3.
3
5
1
2
5
1
2
3
B060778E46
CO
INSPECT NO. 3 FAN RELAY (Marking: FAN NO. 3)
(a) Remove the relay from the engine room relay block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the relay.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to
terminals 1 and 2)
If the result is not as specified, replace the relay.
(c) Install the relay.
CO–29
1NZ-FXE COOLING – RADIATOR
RADIATOR
1NZ-FXE COOLING
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
x6
Clip
RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
8.5 (87, 75 in.*lbf)
21 (214, 16)
20 (204, 15)
COOLER BRACKET
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
INVERTER
BRACKET
x5
x2
25 (255, 18)
CO
RADIATOR SUPPORT
HOOD LOCK CONTROL CABLE
HOOD LOCK ASSEMBLY
HORN CONNECTOR
FRONT BUMPER COVER
ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A124649E01
CO–30
1NZ-FXE COOLING – RADIATOR
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
FAN ASSEMBLY WITH MOTOR
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
CO
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
RADIATOR SUPPORT UPPER RH
RADIATOR SUPPORT UPPER LH
NO. 2 INVERTER COOLING HOSE
WIRE HARNESS
RADIATOR INLET HOSE
FAN MOTOR CONNECTOR
RADIATOR OUTLET HOSE
FAN CONNECTOR
NO. 1 INVERTER COOLING
HOSE
TEMPERATURE SWITCH CONNECTOR
HOSE CLAMP
RADIATOR DRAIN COCK PLUG
NO. 5 INVERTER COOLING HOSE
NO. 1 HEAT STORAGE WATER BY-PASS HOSE
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A124650E01
CO–31
1NZ-FXE COOLING – RADIATOR
RADIATOR FAN
TEMPERATURE
SWITCH
NO. 2 RADIATOR ASSEMBLY
CO
3.9 (40, 35 in.*lbf)
RADIATOR SUPPORT LOWER RH
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
3.9 (40, 35 in.*lbf)
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
RADIATOR SUPPORT LOWER LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A124651E01
CO–32
1NZ-FXE COOLING – RADIATOR
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
1
4
2
)
3
A110260
(5) Pump the cap tester several times, and check
the maximum pressure*.
NOTICE:
When using the cap tester, keep the tester
at an angle of 30° or more above horizontal.
Pumping speed:
1 pump per second
*: Even if the cap cannot maintain the
maximum pressure, it is not a defect.
Judgment criterion
Radiator Cap Tester
30°or more
Radiator Cap
CO
CHECK RADIATOR CAP SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Measure the valve opening pressure.
(1) If there are water stains or foreign matter on
rubber packing 1, 2 or 3, clean the part(s) with
water and finger scouring.
(2) Check that 1, 2 or 3 is not deformed, cracked or
swollen.
(3) Check that 3 and 4 are not stuck together.
(4) Apply engine coolant to 2 and 3 before using
the radiator cap tester.
A085446E01
Item
Specified Condition
Standard value
(for brand-new cap)
93.3 to 122.7 kPa (0.95 to 1.25 kgf/
Minimum standard value
(after using cap)
78.5 kPa (0.8 kgf/cm2, 11.4 psi)
cm2, 13.5 to 17.8 psi)
If the maximum pressure is less than the
minimum standard value, replace the radiator
cap sub-assembly.
ON-VEHICLE CLEANING
1.
A099252E02
CHECK FINS FOR BLOCKAGE
(a) Check that the radiator and condenser are not
blocked with leaves, dirt, or insects. Clean the hose
connections.
If the fins are blocked, wash them with water or a
steam cleaner.
NOTICE:
• If the distance between the steam cleaner and
core is too close, the fins may be damaged.
• Keep the following injection distance.
Standard injection distance
Injection Pressure
Specified Condition
2,942 to 4,903 kPa
300 mm (11.81 in.)
(30 to 50 kgf/cm2, 427 to 711 psi)
4,903 to 7,845 kPa
500 mm (19.69 in.)
(50 to 80 kgf/cm2, 711 to 1,138 psi)
• If the fins are bent, straighten them with a
screwdriver or pliers.
• Never apply water directly onto the electronic
components.
(b) Dry the fins with compressed air.
1NZ-FXE COOLING – RADIATOR
CO–33
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE FAN ASSEMBLY WITH MOTOR
(a) Remove the fan with motor (see page CO-19).
2.
REMOVE NO. 2 RADIATOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 3 bolts and radiator support upper RH.
(b) Remove the 3 bolts and radiator support upper LH.
(c) Remove the 3 bolts and radiator support lower RH.
(d) Remove the 3 bolts and radiator support lower LH.
(e) Remove the No. 2 radiator from the vehicle.
CO
A086932E01
3.
REMOVE RADIATOR FAN TEMPERATURE SWITCH
(a) Using SST, remove the radiator fan temperature
switch.
SST 09817-33190
SST
A086933E01
INSTALLATION
1.
SST
A086933E01
INSTALL RADIATOR FAN TEMPERATURE SWITCH
(a) Using SST, install the radiator fan temperature
switch.
SST 09817-33190
Torque: 7.0 N*m (71 kgf*cm, 62 in.*lbf)
CO–34
1NZ-FXE COOLING – RADIATOR
2.
INSTALL NO. 2 RADIATOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the No. 2 radiator to the vehicle.
(b) Install the radiator support lower LH with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 5.0 N*m (51 kgf*cm, 44 in.*lbf) for bolt A
3.9 N*m (40 kgf*cm, 35 in.*lbf) for bolt B
(c) Install the radiator support lower RH with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 5.0 N*m (51 kgf*cm, 44 in.*lbf) for bolt A
3.9 N*m (40 kgf*cm, 35 in.*lbf) for bolt B
(d) Install the radiator support upper LH with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 5.0 N*m (51 kgf*cm, 44 in.*lbf) for bolt A
3.9 N*m (40 kgf*cm, 35 in.*lbf) for bolt B
(e) Install the radiator support upper RH with the 3
bolts.
Torque: 5.0 N*m (51 kgf*cm, 44 in.*lbf) for bolt A
3.9 N*m (40 kgf*cm, 35 in.*lbf) for bolt B
3.
INSTALL FAN ASSEMBLY WITH MOTOR
(a) Install the fan with motor (see page CO-22).
A
A
A
A
B
B
B
A
B
A
A
A
A086934E01
CO
CO–35
1NZ-FXE COOLING – COOLANT HEAT STORAGE TANK
COOLANT HEAT STORAGE TANK
1NZ-FXE COOLING
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
CLIP
x6
RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
COOLANT
HEAT
STORAGE
TANK
ASSEMBLY
FRONT BUMPER COVER
19 (194, 14)
FRONT FENDER LINER LH
NO. 1 HEAT STORAGE WATER BY-PASS HOSE
x2
x2
19 (194, 14)
19 (194, 14)
NO. 1 HEAT STORAGE WATER BY-PASS HOSE
DRAIN COCK PLUG
ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
WATER PUMP CONNECTOR
TEMPERATURE SENSOR CONNECTOR
ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A124653E01
CO
CO–36
1NZ-FXE COOLING – COOLANT HEAT STORAGE TANK
REMOVAL
CAUTION:
• Before and after the procedure, be sure to check DTCs
and confirm that no DTCs are output.
• If the tank has any malfunctions, the tank surface
becomes hot. To prevent injuries from burns, do not
touch the tank.
• The coolant heat storage tank assembly is prohibited
from being disassembled and can be disassembled
only as instructed.
1.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
2.
REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-4)
3.
REMOVE REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
4.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM BATTERY NEGATIVE
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
5.
REMOVE RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
(See page CO-6)
6.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
7.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
8.
REMOVE FRONT BUMPER COVER (See page ET-4)
9.
REMOVE FRONT FENDER LINER LH
(a) Partially remove the front fender liner LH.
CO
10. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT
(a) Loosen the drain cock plug, then drain the coolant.
CAUTION:
Even if the engine is cold, the coolant in the
coolant heat storage tank is still hot. Be careful
of the hot coolant when draining it.
A086936E01
11. REMOVE COOLANT HEAT STORAGE TANK
ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the 2 hoses.
A087327E01
1NZ-FXE COOLING – COOLANT HEAT STORAGE TANK
CO–37
(b) Disconnect the water pump motor and temperature
sensor connectors.
A086935E01
(c) Remove the nut and 4 bolts.
NOTICE:
The coolant heat storage tank bracket can be
easily bent. Hold the coolant heat storage tank
tightly when removing the nut and bolts.
CO
A087328E01
(d) Separate the stud bolt and 2 claws shown in the
illustration, then remove the coolant heat storage
tank.
Stud Bolt
Claw
Claw
A087329E01
CO–38
1NZ-FXE COOLING – COOLANT HEAT STORAGE TANK
INSTALLATION
1.
Insert Stud Bolt
Stud Bolt
INSTALL COOLANT HEAT STORAGE TANK
ASSEMBLY
(a) Insert the 2 claws shown in the illustration to the
vehicle side, then insert the stud bolt to the vehicle
side.
NOTICE:
The coolant storage tank bracket can be easily
bent. Hold the coolant storage tank tightly when
inserting the claws and stud bolt.
Insert Claws
Claws
Claws
A087330E02
CO
(b) Install the 4 bolts and nut.
Torque: 19 N*m (194 kgf*cm, 14 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
• When tightening bolt 1 and 2, push the
coolant heat storage tank bracket to the
vehicle front.
• The coolant heat storage tank bracket can be
easily bent. Hold the coolant heat storage
tank tightly when installing the bolts and nut.
5
3
1
4
2
A087331E01
(c) Connect the water pump motor and temperature
sensor connectors.
A086935E01
1NZ-FXE COOLING – COOLANT HEAT STORAGE TANK
CO–39
(d) Connect the 2 hoses shown in the illustration.
2.
CONNECT CABLE TO BATTERY NEGATIVE
TERMINAL
3.
INSTALL REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
4.
INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-8)
5.
INSTALL REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
6.
ADD ENGINE COOLANT (See page HX-58)
7.
CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS
8.
INSTALL FRONT FENDER LINER LH
9.
INSTALL FRONT BUMPER COVER (See page ET-6)
A087327E01
10. INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
11. INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
12. INSTALL RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
(See page CO-9)
13. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting the cable from the negative (-)
battery terminal.
CO
CO–40
1NZ-FXE COOLING – COOLANT HEAT STORAGE WATER PUMP
COOLANT HEAT STORAGE WATER PUMP
1NZ-FXE COOLING
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
CLIP
x6
RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
CO
ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
FRONT FENDER LINER LH
NO. 1 HEAT STORAGE WATER BY-PASS HOSE
x2
x4
x3
COOLANT HEAT
STORAGE WATER
PUMP
WATER BY-PASS HOSE
6.0 (61, 53 in.*lbf)
WATER PUMP CONNECTOR
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A124652E01
1NZ-FXE COOLING – COOLANT HEAT STORAGE WATER PUMP
CO–41
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE REAR FLOOR NO. 2 BOARD (See page CH4)
2.
REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-4)
3.
REMOVE REAR FLOOR NO. 3 BOARD (See page CH4)
4.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM BATTERY NEGATIVE
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
5.
REMOVE RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
(See page CO-6)
6.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL LH
7.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
8.
REMOVE FRONT FENDER LINER LH
(a) Partially remove the front fender liner LH.
9.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page HX-58)
10. REMOVE COOLANT HEAT STORAGE WATER PUMP
(a) Disconnect the coolant heat storage water pump
connector.
(b) Disconnect the 2 hoses.
A087332E01
(c) Remove the bolt and coolant heat storage water
pump.
A087333E01
CO
CO–42
1NZ-FXE COOLING – COOLANT HEAT STORAGE WATER PUMP
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL COOLANT HEAT STORAGE WATER PUMP
(a) Install the coolant heat storage pump water pump
with the bolt.
Torque: 6.0 N*m (61 kgf*cm, 53 in.*lbf)
A087333E01
(b) Connect the 2 hoses.
(c) Connect the connector to the coolant heat storage
pump.
2.
CONNECT CABLE TO BATTERY NEGATIVE
TERMINAL
3.
INSTALL REAR FLOOR NO. 3 BOARD (See page CH8)
4.
INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-8)
5.
INSTALL REAR FLOOR NO. 2 BOARD (See page CH8)
6.
ADD ENGINE COOLANT (See page HX-58)
7.
CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS
8.
INSTALL FRONT FENDER LINER LH
9.
INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
A087332E01
CO
10. INSTALL FRONT WHEEL LH
Torque: 103 N*m (1050 kgf*cm, 76 ft.*lbf)
11. INSTALL RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
(See page CO-9)
12. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DL–1
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL
SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
1.
NOTICE FOR INITIALIZATION
When disconnecting the cable from the negative (-)
battery terminal, initialize the following system(s) after
the cable is reconnected.
System Name
See procedure
Power Window Control System
IN-32
2.
NOTICE FOR HYBRID SYSTEM ACTIVATION
When the warning light is illuminated or the battery has
been disconnected and reconnected, pressing the power
switch may not start the system on the first try. If so,
press the power switch again.
DL
DL–2
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MASTER SWITCH
(DOOR CONTROL SWITCH)
FRONT DOOR LOCK ASSEMBLY LH
- DOOR LOCK MOTOR
- DOOR POSITION SWITCH
- DOOR LOCK AND UNLOCK SWITCH
REAR DOOR LOCK ASSEMBLY LH
- DOOR LOCK MOTOR
- DOOR POSITION SWITCH
POWER SWITCH
KEY SLOT
- HALFWAY SWITCH
DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
- BODY ECU
- DOOR FUSE
TRANSPONDER KEY ECU
DOOR CONTROL
SWITCH
DL
FRONT DOOR LOCK ASSEMBLY RH
- DOOR LOCK MOTOR
- DOOR POSITION SWITCH
BACK DOOR OPENER SWITCH
BACK DOOR LOCK ASSEMBLY
- BACK DOOR COURTESY LIGHT SWITCH
REAR DOOR LOCK ASSEMBLY RH
- DOOR LOCK MOTOR
- DOOR POSITION SWITCH
w/ Smart Key System
FRONT DOOR COURTESY
LIGHT SWITCH ASSEMBLY LH
LUGGAGE ELECTRICAL KEY SWITCH
B140394E01
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DL–3
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
Power Window Regulator Master Switch
(Door Control Switch)
Door Control Switch
Front Door Courtesy Light Switch LH
Back Door Opener Switch*1
DL
Driver Side Junction
Block
(Main Body ECU)
Luggage Electrical Key Switch*2
Front Door Lock LH
Front Door Lock RH
Rear Door Lock LH
Rear Door Lock RH
BEAN
(Instrument Panel Bus)
Key Slot
Transponder Key ECU
B127005E01
DL–4
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
2.
DL
POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DESCRIPTION
The power door lock system locks/unlocks all the doors
simultaneously.
The master switch (on the driver side door) and the door
control switch (on the passenger side door) send lock/
unlock request signals to the body ECU. Then, the body
ECU sends these requests to the lock motors in each
door to lock/unlock all the doors simultaneously.
Operating the driver side door lock using a key sends
lock/unlock request signals to the door lock control relay.
The driver side door key-linked lock function has an
optional unlock method called the 2-step unlock function.
FUNCTION OF MAIN COMPONENT
Components
Function
Master switch
Door control switch on master switch assembly locks/unlocks all doors
Door control switch
Door control switch on passenger side door locks/unlocks all doors
Door courtesy switch
Placed on each door. Detects door status (open or closed) and
outputs data to body ECU. Turns on when door is open and turns off
when door is closed.
Driver side door lock
•
•
•
•
•
Passenger side door lock
Rear LH door lock
Rear RH door lock
3.
Built-in motor locks/unlocks door
Built-in door control switch (key-linked) detects door key
operation's door status (locked or unlocked) and outputs data to
body ECU
Built-in position switch detects door status (locked or unlocked)
and outputs data to body ECU. This switch turns off when door is
locked and turns on when door is unlocked.
Built-in motor locks/unlocks door
Built-in position switch detects door status (locked or unlocked)
and outputs data to body ECU. This switch turns off when door is
locked and turns on when door is unlocked.
SYSTEM FUNCTION
This system is controlled by the body ECU. The body
ECU outputs signals to each door lock motor. The door
lock control system in the PRIUS has the following
functions:
Function
Outline
Manual lock and unlock function
Locks/unlocks all doors by door control switch's lock operation
(manual operation)
Key-linked lock and unlock function
Linked with door key cylinder. Locks/unlocks all doors when lock/
unlock operation is possible.
Key lock-in prevention function
When key is inserted in key slot with driver side door open and door
lock operation is performed, all doors will be unlocked.
Manual unlock prohibition function
Performing door lock operation with transmitter, mechanical key or
smart lock function* disables unlock operation by door lock control
switch
2-step unlock function
Unlock only driver side door by turning door key cylinder once and
unlock remaining doors by turning it twice
All doors lock with transmitter
Pressing transmitter's lock switch locks all doors
All doors unlock with transmitter
Pressing transmitter's unlock switch once unlocks driver side door and
pressing it again within 3 seconds unlocks remaining doors
Entry unlock function*
User can unlock all doors by keeping smart key in his/her possession
and touching outside door handle
Entry lock function*
User can lock all doors by keeping smart key in his/her possession
and pressing lock switch on outside door handle
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DL–5
HINT:
*: w/ Smart key system
DL
DL–6
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
• Use this procedure to troubleshoot the power door lock
control system.
• *: Using the intelligent tester.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS CHECK AND SYMPTOM CHECK
NEXT
DL
3
INSPECT BATTERY VOLTAGE
Standard voltage:
11 to 14 V
If the voltage is below 11 V, recharge or replace the battery
before proceeding.
NEXT
4
INSPECT COMMUNICATION FUNCTION OF LARGE-SCALE MULTIPLEX
COMMUNICATION SYSTEM (BEAN)*
(a) Use the intelligent tester to check if the Multiplex
Communication System (MPX) is functioning normally.
Result
Result
Proceed to
MPX DTC is not output
A
MPX DTC is output
B
B
Go to MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION
SYSTEM
A
5
CHECK FOR DTC*
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC is not output
A
DTC is output
B
B
Go to step 7
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DL–7
A
6
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Result
Result
Proceed to
Fault is not listed in problem symptoms table
A
Fault is listed in problem symptoms table
B
B
Go to step 8
A
7
OVERALL ANALYSIS AND TROUBLESHOOTING
(a) Operation check (see page DL-6)
(b) Terminals of ECU (see page DL-9)
(c) DATA LIST/ACTIVE TEST (see page DL-15)
NEXT
8
REPAIR OR REPLACE
NEXT
9
NEXT
END
CONFIRMATION TEST
DL
DL–8
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
OPERATION CHECK
1.
DL
CHECK ELECTRICAL DOOR LOCK OPERATION
(a) Check the basic function.
(1) For the door control switch (manual operation):
1) pushing the LOCK switch locks all the doors;
and 2) pushing the UNLOCK switch unlocks all
the doors.
(2) For the driver side door key cylinder lock
function: turning the driver side door key cylinder
to the LOCK position locks all the doors.
(3) For the driver side door key cylinder unlock
function: 1) turning the driver side door key
cylinder to the UNLOCK position unlocks the
driver side door; and 2) turning it to the UNLOCK
position again within 3 seconds unlocks the
remaining doors (2-step unlock function).
(b) Check the key lock-in prevention function.
NOTICE:
To prevent the key from being locked in the
vehicle, the following inspection should be
made with the driver side door window open.
(1) Insert the key into the key slot.
(2) With the driver side door open, turn the driver
side door lock knob to the LOCK position and
check that all the doors unlock immediately.
(3) With the driver side door open, push the LOCK
switch on the door control switch (manual
operation) and check that all the doors unlock
immediately.
(4) With the driver side door open, turn the driver
side door lock knob to the LOCK position, hold it
for at least 2 seconds and then close the driver
side door. Check that all the doors unlock.
(c) Check the security function.
(1) Close all the doors and leave the driver side
door window open so that the door control
switch can be operated from outside the vehicle.
(2) Pull out the key, open the driver side door and
then close and lock the door without using the
key. Check that pushing the UNLOCK switch on
the door control switch (manual operation) from
outside the vehicle does not unlock the doors.
(3) Pull out the key, close and lock the driver side
door by key operation. Check that pushing
UNLOCK switch on the door control switch
(manual operation) from outside the vehicle
does not unlock the doors.
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DL–9
(4) Pull out the key, close the driver side door and
lock the door by wireless door lock operation.
Check that pushing the UNLOCK switch on the
door control switch (manual operation) from
outside the vehicle does not unlock the doors.
HINT:
Check that the security function is canceled
when any of the following conditions is met:
• The power switch is turned ON (IG).
• The driver side door is unlocked using the
key.
• The UNLOCK switch on the door control
switch (for manual operation) is pushed after
the door lock knob is manually turned to the
UNLOCK position.
• The doors are unlocked with wireless or
smart unlock operation.
DL
DL–10
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
Use the table below to help determine the cause of the
problem symptom. The potential causes of the symptoms are
listed in order of probability in the "Suspected area" column of
the table. Check each symptom by checking the suspected
areas in the order they are listed. Replace parts as
necessary.
Power door lock control system
Symptom
All doors lock / unlock functions do not operate via
master switch
DL
All door lock / unlock do not operate via door control
switch
All door lock / unlock do not operate via driver side
door key cylinder
Only driver side door lock / unlock functions do not
operate
Only passenger side door lock / unlock functions do
not operate
Only rear LH side door lock / unlock functions do not
operate
Only rear RH side door lock / unlock functions do not
operate
Only back door lock / unlock functions do not operate
Key lock-in prevention function does not work properly
(manual operation and key-linked lock are available)
Suspected area
See page
1. DOOR fuse
DL-25
2. DOME fuse
-
3. Power window regulator master switch
-
4. Wire harness
-
5. Driver side junction block (Main body ECU)
-
1. Door control switch
DL-28
2. Wire harness
-
3. Driver side junction block (Main body ECU)
-
1. Front door lock LH
DL-30
2. Wire harness
-
3. Driver side junction block (Main body ECU)
-
1. Front door lock LH
DL-33
2. Wire harness
-
3. Driver side junction block (Main body ECU)
-
1. Front door lock RH
DL-37
2. Wire harness
-
3. Driver side junction block (Main body ECU)
-
1. Rear door lock LH
DL-40
2. Wire harness
-
3. Driver side junction block (Main body ECU)
-
1. Rear door lock RH
DL-43
2. Wire harness
-
3. Driver side junction block (Main body ECU)
-
1. Back door lock
DL-46
2. Luggage electrical key switch (w/ Smart key system)
-
3. Back door opener switch (w/o Smart key system)
-
4. Wire harness
-
5. Driver side junction block (Main body ECU)
-
1. Key slot
DL-52
2. Front door courtesy light switch LH
-
3. Wire harness
-
4. Driver side junction block (Main body ECU)
-
5. Transponder key ECU
-
DL–11
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
CHECK POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MASTER
SWITCH
P17
10
20
9 8 7 6 5 4 3
19 18 17 16 15 14 13
2
1
12 11
B105772E04
(a) Disconnect the P17 switch connector.
(b) Measure the voltage and resistance of the wire
harness side connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
BDR (P17-11) - Body
ground
V - Body ground
+B (BDR) power supply
Always
10 to 14 V
BW (P17-7) - Body ground
W - Body ground
+B (BW) power supply
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
BW (P17-7) - Body ground
W - Body ground
+B (BW) power supply
Power switch OFF
Below 1 V
E (P17-1) - Body ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
L (P17-5) - Body ground
LG - Body ground
Door control switch door
lock input
Door control switch LOCK
Below 1 Ω
L (P17-5) - Body ground
LG - Body ground
Door control switch door
lock input
Door control switch OFF
10 kΩ or higher
UL (P17-8) - Body ground
BR - Body ground
Door control switch door
unlock input
Door control switch
UNLOCK
Below 1 Ω
UL (P17-8) - Body ground
BR - Body ground
Door control switch door
unlock input
Door control switch OFF
10 kΩ or higher
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
DL
DL–12
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
2.
CHECK DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK (MAIN
BODY ECU)
Vehicle Rear Side
1D
Vehicle Front Side
B5
B7
1A
1H
1E
1B
DL
Main Body ECU
1D
1A
1E
1H
B5
B7
1B
B079545E02
(a) Disconnect the 1A, 1B, 1D, 1E and 1H junction
block connectors.
(b) Disconnect the B5 and B7 ECU connectors.
DL–13
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
(c) Measure the voltage and resistance of the wire
harness side connectors.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
ALTB (1B-1) - Body
ground
W - Body ground
+B (power system,
generator system) power
supply
Always
10 to 14 V
ECUB (1A-30) - Body
ground
R - Body ground
+B (ECUB) power supply
Always
10 to 14 V
GND (1E-17) - Body
ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
KSW (1E-26) - Body
ground*1
KSW (1E-23) - Body
ground*2
Y - Body ground
Key unlock warning switch
input
Key inserted
Below 1 Ω
KSW (1E-26) - Body
ground*1
KSW (1E-23) - Body
ground*2
Y - Body ground
Key unlock warning switch
input
No key in key slot
10 kΩ or higher
L1 (1H-4) - Body ground
LG - Body ground
Door control switch
(master switch and
passenger side switch)
lock input
Door control switch
(master switch or
passenger side switch)
LOCK
Below 1 Ω
DL
L1 (1H-4) - Body ground
LG - Body ground
Door control switch
(master switch and
passenger side switch)
lock input
Door control switch
(master switch or
passenger side switch)
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
L1 (1H-13) - Body ground
B - Body ground
Door control switch
(master switch and
passenger side switch)
lock input
Door control switch
(master switch or
passenger side switch)
LOCK
Below 1 Ω
L1 (1H-13) - Body ground
B - Body ground
Door control switch
(master switch and
passenger side switch)
lock input
Door control switch
(master switch or
passenger side switch)
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
UL1 (1H-5) - Body ground
BR - Body ground
Door control switch
(master switch and
passenger side switch)
unlock input
Door control switch
(master switch or
passenger side switch)
UNLOCK
Below 1 Ω
UL1 (1H-5) - Body ground
BR - Body ground
Door control switch
(master switch and
passenger side switch)
unlock input
Door control switch
(master switch or
passenger side switch)
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
UL1 (1H-14) - Body
ground
V - Body ground
Door control switch
(master switch and
passenger side switch)
unlock input
Door control switch
(master switch or
passenger side switch)
UNLOCK
Below 1 Ω
UL1 (1H-14) - Body
ground
V - Body ground
Door control switch
(master switch and
passenger side switch)
unlock input
Door control switch
(master switch or
passenger side switch)
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
L2 (1H-16) - Body ground
L - Body ground
L - Body ground
Driver side door key-linked
door lock input
Driver side door key
cylinder LOCK
Below 1 Ω
L2 (1H-16) - Body ground
L - Body ground
L - Body ground
Driver side door key-linked
door lock input
Driver side door key
cylinder OFF
10 kΩ or higher
UL3 (B7-9) - Body ground
P - Body ground
Driver side door key-linked
door unlock input
Driver side door key
cylinder UNLOCK
Below 1 Ω
UL3 (B7-9) - Body ground
P - Body ground
Driver side door key-linked
door unlock input
Driver side door key
cylinder OFF
10 kΩ or higher
LSWD (B7-25) - Body
ground
LG - Body ground
Driver side door lock
position switch input
Driver side door LOCK
Below 1 Ω
LSWD (B7-25) - Body
ground
LG - Body ground
Driver side door lock
position switch input
Driver side door UNLOCK
10 kΩ or higher
DL–14
DL
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
LSWP (B7-10) - Body
ground
Y - Body ground
Passenger side door lock
position switch input
Passenger side door
LOCK
Below 1 Ω
LSWP (B7-10) - Body
ground
Y - Body ground
Passenger side door lock
position switch input
Passenger side door
UNLOCK
10 kΩ or higher
LSWR (B5-10) - Body
ground
O - Body ground
Rear doors lock position
switch input
Rear doors LOCK
Below 1 Ω
LSWR (B5-10) - Body
ground
O - Body ground
Rear doors lock position
switch input
Rear doors UNLOCK
10 kΩ or higher
DCTY (1D-21) - Body
ground
V - Body ground
Driver side courtesy
switch input
Driver side door open
Below 1 Ω
DCTY (1D-21) - Body
ground
V - Body ground
Driver side courtesy
switch input
Driver side door closed
10 kΩ or higher
PCTY (1D-24) - Body
ground
BR - Body ground
Passenger side courtesy
switch input
Passenger side door open
Below 1 Ω
PCTY (1D-24) - Body
ground
BR - Body ground
Passenger side courtesy
switch input
Passenger side door
closed
10 kΩ or higher
RCTY (1D-5) - Body
ground
R - Body ground
Rear LH courtesy switch
input
Rear LH door open
Below 1 Ω
RCTY (1D-5) - Body
ground
R - Body ground
Rear LH courtesy switch
input
Rear LH door closed
10 kΩ or higher
RCTY (1D-20) - Body
ground
R - Body ground
Rear RH courtesy switch
input
Rear RH door open
Below 1 Ω
RCTY (1D-20) - Body
ground
R - Body ground
Rear RH courtesy switch
input
Rear RH door closed
10 kΩ or higher
BCTY (1D-7) - Body
ground
R - Body ground
Back door courtesy switch
input
Back door open
Below 1 Ω
BCTY (1D-7) - Body
ground
R - Body ground
Back door courtesy switch
input
Back door closed
10 kΩ or higher
BDSU (B7-12) - Body
ground
P - Body ground
Back door opener switch
input
Back door opener switch
ON
Below 1 Ω
BDSU (B7-12) - Body
ground
P - Body ground
Back door opener switch
input
Back door opener switch
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
HINT:
*1: w/ Smart key system
*2: w/o Smart key system
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
(d) Reconnect the 1A, 1B, 1D, 1E and 1H junction block
connectors.
(e) Reconnect the B5 and B7 ECU connectors.
(f) Measure the voltage of the connectors.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
ACT+ (1H-8) - Body
ground
Y - Body ground
Door lock motor LOCK
drive output (driver side
door)
Door control switch
(master switch or
passenger side switch) or
driver side door key
cylinder
OFF →
LOCK →
OFF
Below 1 V →
10 to 14 V →
Below 1 V
ACT+ (1D-3) - Body
ground
Y - Body ground
Door lock motor LOCK
drive output (passenger
side door)
Door control switch
(master switch or
passenger side switch) or
driver side door key
cylinder
OFF →
LOCK →
OFF
Below 1 V →
10 to 14 V →
Below 1 V
DL–15
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
ACT+ (1H-17) - Body
ground
Y - Body ground
Door lock motor LOCK
drive output (rear LH and
rear RH side door)
Door control switch
(master switch or
passenger side switch) or
driver side door key
cylinder
OFF →
LOCK →
OFF
Below 1 V →
10 to 14 V →
Below 1 V
ACTD (B7-5)) - Body
ground
G - Body ground
Door lock motor UNLOCK
drive output (driver side
door)
Door control switch
(master switch or
passenger side switch) or
driver side door key
cylinder
OFF →
UNLOCK →
OFF
Below 1 V →
10 to 14 V →
Below 1 V
ACT- (1H-9) - Body
ground
G - Body ground
Door lock motor UNLOCK
drive output (passenger
side door)
Door control switch
(master switch or
passenger side switch) or
driver side door key
cylinder
OFF →
UNLOCK →
OFF
Below 1 V →
10 to 14 V →
Below 1 V
DL
ACT- (1D-4) - Body
ground
G - Body ground
Door lock motor UNLOCK
drive output (rear LH side
door)
Door control switch
(master switch or
passenger side switch) or
driver side door key
cylinder
OFF →
UNLOCK →
OFF
Below 1 V →
10 to 14 V →
Below 1 V
BACT (B7-1) - Body
ground
Y - Body ground
Back door lock motor
OPEN drive output
Transmitter switch (back
door)
OFF →
UNLOCK →
OFF
Below 1 V →
10 to 14 V →
Below 1 V
3.
If the result is not as specified, the junction block
may have a malfunction.
CHECK TRANSPONDER KEY ECU
T5
9 8 7 6
5 4 3 2 1
24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10
B126056E02
(a) Disconnect the T5 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the voltage and resistance of the wire
harness side connectors.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
CPUB (T5-3) - Body
ground
L - Body ground
+B (CPUB) power supply
Always
10 to 14 V
GND (T5-22) - Body
ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
IG (T5-4) - Body ground
O - Body ground
IG power supply
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
DL–16
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
IG (T5-4) - Body ground
O - Body ground
IG power supply
Power switch OFF
Below 1 V
ACC (T5-12) - Body
ground
P - Body ground
ACC power supply
Power switch ON (ACC)
10 to 14 V
ACC (T5-12) - Body
ground
P - Body ground
ACC power supply
Power switch OFF
Below 1 V
CUWS (T5-5) - Body
ground
B - Body ground
Halfway switch input
Key inserted
Below 1 Ω
CUWS (T5-5) - Body
ground
B - Body ground
Halfway switch input
No key in key slot
10 kΩ or higher
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
DL
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DL–17
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
CG
SG
1.
DESCRIPTION
The main body ECU controls the functions of the power
door lock control system on the vehicle. Data of the
power door lock control system and Diagnostic Trouble
Code (DTCs) can be read in the Data Link Connector 3
(DLC3) of the vehicle.
When the system seems to be malfunctioning, use the
intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to check for a
malfunction and perform repairs.
2.
CHECK DLC3
The vehicle's ECU uses the ISO 15765-4 communication
protocol. The terminal arrangement of the DLC3
complies with ISO 15031-03 and matches the ISO
15765-4 format.
SIL
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
BAT
9 10 11 1213141516
DL
A082779E50
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
SIL (7) - SG (5)
Bus "+" line
During transmission
Pulse generation
CG (4) - Body ground Chassis
ground
Chassis ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
SG (5) - Body ground Signal
ground
Signal ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
BAT (16) - Body ground
Battery positive
Always
11 to 14 V
CANH (6) - CANL (14)
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Power switch is OFF*
54 to 67 Ω
CANH (6) - Battery positive
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Power switch is OFF*
1 MΩ or higher
CANH (6) - CG (4)
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Power switch is OFF*
3 MΩ or higher
CANL (14) - Battery position
LOW-level CAN bus line
Power switch is OFF*
1 MΩ or higher
CANL (14) - CG (4)
LOW-level CAN bus line
Power switch is OFF*
3 MΩ or higher
NOTICE:
*: Before measuring the resistance, leave the vehicle
as is for at least 1 minute and do not operate the
power switch, any other switches or the doors.
If the result is not as specified, the DLC3 may have a
malfunction. Repair or replace the harness and
connector.
DL–18
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
HINT:
Connect the cable of the intelligent tester (with CAN
VIM) to the DLC3, turn the power switch ON (IG) and
attempt to use the tester. If the display indicates that a
communication error has occurred, there is a problem
either with the vehicle or with the tester.
• If communication is normal when the tester is
connected to another vehicle, inspect the DLC3 on
the original vehicle.
• If communication is still not possible when the tester
is connected to another vehicle, the problem may be
in the tester itself. Consult the Service Department
listed in the tester's instruction
Intelligent Tester
DLC3
CAN VIM
A082795E04
DTC CHECK / CLEAR
1.
DL
Intelligent Tester
DLC3
CAN VIM
2.
A082795E04
CHECK DTC
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the Controller Area
Network Vehicle Interface Module (CAN VIM). Then
connect the CAN VIM to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Read DTCs by following the prompts on the tester
screen.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual for
further details.
CLEAR DTC
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Erase the DTCs following the prompts on the tester
screen.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual for
further details.
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DL–19
DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST
1.
REAR DATA LIST
HINT:
Using the intelligent tester's DATA LIST allows switch,
sensor, actuator and other item values to be read without
removing any parts.
Reading the DATA LIST early in troubleshooting is one
way to save time.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Read the DATA LIST according to the display on the
tester.
Main body ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
TRNK/B DOR OPEN
Back door open judgment /
PROHIBT or PERMIT
PROHIBT: Back door opening is
impossible
PERMIT: Back door opening is
possible
-
D DOR CTY SW
Driver side door courtesy switch
signal / ON or OFF
ON: Driver side door is open
OFF: Driver side door is closed
-
P LOCK POS SW
Passenger side door lock
position switch signal / ON or
OFF
ON: Passenger side door lock is in
unlock position
OFF: Passenger side door lock is
in lock position
-
Rr DOR CTY SW
Rear door courtesy switch
signal / ON or OFF
ON: Either right or left rear door is
open
OFF: Both right and left rear doors
are closed
-
Rr LOCK POS SW
Rear door lock position switch
signal / ON or OFF
ON: Rear door lock is in unlock
position
OFF: Rear door lock is in lock
position
-
B DOR OPEN SW
Back door opener switch signal /
ON or OFF
ON: Back door opener switch is
pushed
OFF: Back door opener switch is
not pushed
-
D LOCK POS SW
Driver side door lock position
switch signal / ON or OFF
ON: Driver side door lock is in
unlock position
OFF: Driver side door lock is in
lock position
-
D/L SW-LOCK
Door control switch lock signal /
ON or OFF
ON: Door control switch is in lock
position
OFF: Door control switch is not in
lock position
-
D/L SW-UNLOCK
Door control switch unlock
signal / ON or OFF
ON: Door control switch is in
unlock position
OFF: Door control switch is not in
unlock position
-
DOR KEY SW-LOCK
Driver door lock/unlock switch
lock signal (key-linked lock
switch) / ON or OFF
ON: Driver side door key cylinder is
turned to lock position
OFF: Driver side door key cylinder
is not turned to lock position
-
D DOR KEY SW-UN
Driver door lock/unlock switch
unlock signal (key-linked unlock
switch) / ON or OFF
ON: Driver side door key cylinder is
turned to unlock position
OFF: Driver side door key cylinder
is not turned to unlock position
-
DL
DL–20
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
2.
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST
HINT:
Performing the intelligent tester's ACTIVE TEST allows
relay, VSV actuator and other items to be operated
without removing any parts. Performing the ACTIVE
TEST early in troubleshooting is one way to save time.
The DATA LIST can be displayed during the ACTIVE
TEST.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Perform the ACTIVE TEST according to the display
on the tester.
Main body ECU
DL
Item
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
DOOR LOCK
Operate door lock motor for all doors LOCK /
UNLOCK
All doors are closed
DL–21
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
HINT:
If a malfunction code is displayed during the DTC check,
check the circuit listed for that code in the table below and
proceed to the page given for that circuit.
Power door lock control system
DTC No.
B1241
Detection Item
Body ECU Switch Circuit
Diagnosis
Trouble Area
See page
- Power window regulator master
switch (door control switch)
- Door control switch
- Driver side junction block (Main
body ECU)
- Wire harness
DL-18
DL
DL–22
DTC
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
B1241
Body ECU Switch Circuit Diagnosis
DESCRIPTION
DTC B1241 output when: 1) the door control switches of the master switch or the door control switch on
the passenger side door are pressed, or 2) when the door lock and unlock switch (door key-linked switch)
built into the front door lock LH is used. DTC B1241 disappears when the switches are not pressed or
used.
A malfunction is occurring when:
• The DTC is output when a switch is not operated. The switch may be stuck ON.
• The switch is not output when a switch is being operated. The switch's contact may be faulty.
DL
Switch Operation (ON)
Switch Operation (OFF)
Switch Condition
DTC is output
DTC is not output
Normal
DTC is output
DTC is output
Stuck ON malfunction
DTC is not output
DTC is not output
Contact is faulty malfunction
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1241
•
•
•
•
Door control switch on master switch is in
lock/unlock position (ON) or stuck
Door control switch on passenger door is
in lock/unlock position (ON) or stuck
Door lock and unlock switch (door keylinked switch) is in lock/unlock position
(ON) or stuck
•
•
•
•
Power window regulator master switch
assembly
Door control switch
Door lock assembly
Driver side junction block (Main body
ECU)
Wire harness
DL–23
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Driver Side Junction Block
DC/DC
DOOR
DOME
from Battery
ALTB
ECUB
Power Window Regulator Master Switch
L1
UL1
DL
Door Control Switch
GND
L2
from
Front Door Lock LH
UL3
B131922E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT FUSE (DOOR)
(a) Remove the DOOR fuse from the driver side junction
block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the fuse.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE FUSE
DL–24
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
OK
2
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (DOOR CONTROL SWITCH)
(a) Check the DATA LIST for proper functioning of the door
control switch.
Main body ECU
Item
Measurement Item/Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
D/L SW-LOCK
Door control switch lock signal
/ ON or OFF
ON: Door control switch is in
LOCK position
OFF: Door control switch is not
in LOCK position
-
D/L SW-UNLOCK
Door control switch unlock
signal / ON or OFF
ON: Door control switch is in
UNLOCK position
OFF: Door control switch is not
in UNLOCK position
-
OK:
ON (door is locked/unlocked) appears on the
screen.
DL
NG
Go to step 4
OK
3
CHECK DOOR LOCK / UNLOCK FUNCTION (OPERATE VIA DRIVER SIDE DOOR KEY
CYLINDER)
(a) Refer to "all doors lock / unlock functions do not operate
via driver side door key cylinder" (see page DL-30).
OK:
Normal operation
OK
NG
REPLACE FRONT DOOR LOCK ASSEMBLY LH
Go to step 6
DL–25
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
4
INSPECT POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MASTER SWITCH (DOOR CONTROL SWITCH)
(a) Measure the resistance of the switch.
Standard resistance
Lock
Unlock
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
1-5
Lock
Below 1 Ω
1-8
Unlock
1-5
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
1-8
Door Control Switch
NG
REPLACE POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
MASTER SWITCH
DL
B059539E17
OK
5
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SWITCH - ECU AND BODY GROUND)
Wire Harness Side
Power Window Regulator Master Switch
P17
E
UL
L
(a) Disconnect the P17 switch connector.
(b) Disconnect the 1H junction block connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
P17-5 (L) - 1H-4 (L1)
Below 1 Ω
P17-8 (UL) - 1H-5 (UL1)
P17-1 (E) - Body ground
NG
Driver Side Junction Block
1H
L1
UL1
B079546E01
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
DL–26
6
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK DOOR CONTROL SWITCH
(a) Press the lock switch on the passenger side door control
switch and check that all the doors lock. Press the unlock
switch on the passenger side door control switch and
check that all the doors unlock.
OK:
All doors lock/unlock when lock/unlock switches
are pressed.
OK
Go to step 9
NG
7
DL
INSPECT DOOR CONTROL SWITCH
(a) Measure the resistance of the switch.
Standard resistance
Lock
Tester Connection
Unlock
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
3-6
Lock
Below 1 Ω
3-5
Unlock
3-6
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
No Pin (4)
B071970E14
OK
NG
REPLACE DOOR CONTROL SWITCH
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
8
DL–27
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SWITCH - ECU AND BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the D11 switch connector.
(b) Disconnect the 1H junction block connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Door Control Switch
D11
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D11-6 - 1H-13 (L1)
Below 1 Ω
D11-5 - 1H-14 (UL1)
D11-3 - Body ground
NG
Driver Side Junction Block
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
DL
1H
L1
UL1
B079547E01
OK
9
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION LOCK - BATTERY AND BODY
GROUND)
Wire Harness Side
Driver Side Junction Block
Driver Side Junction Block
GND
1A
Driver Side Junction Block
1E
1B
ECUB
ALTB
B131923E01
(a) Disconnect the 1A, 1B and 1E junction block connectors.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1A-30 (ECUB) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
1B-1 (ALTB) - Body ground
DL–28
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1E-17 (GND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
OK
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
DL
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DL–29
All Doors LOCK / UNLOCK Functions do not Operate Via Master
Switch
DESCRIPTION
The body ECU in the driver side junction block receives switch signals from the power window regulator
master switch and activates the door lock motors on each door according to the signal.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Driver Side Junction Block
Power Window Regulator Master Switch
L1
DL
UL1
B131924E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (DOOR CONTROL SWITCH)
(a) Check the DATA LIST for proper functioning of the door
control switch.
Main body ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
D/L SW-LOCK
Door control switch lock
signal/ON or OFF
ON: Door control switch is in
LOCK position
OFF: Door control switch is not
in LOCK position
-
SW-UNLOCK
Door control switch unlock
signal / ON or OFF
ON: Door control switch is in
UNLOCK position
OFF: Door control switch is not
in UNLOCK position
-
OK:
ON (door is locked/unlocked) appears on the
screen.
OK
NG
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
DL–30
2
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MASTER SWITCH ASSEMBLY (DOOR
CONTROL SWITCH)
(a) Measure the resistance of the door control switch.
Standard resistance
Lock
Unlock
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
1-5
Lock
Below 1 Ω
1-8
Unlock
1-5
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
1-8
Door Control Switch
NG
REPLACE POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
MASTER SWITCH
DL
B059539E17
OK
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (MASTER SWITCH - DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK AND
BODY GROUND)
Wire Harness Side
Power Window Regulator Master Switch
P17
E
UL
L
(a) Disconnect the P17 switch connector.
(b) Disconnect the 1H junction block connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
17-5 (L) - 1H-4 (L1)
Below 1 Ω
P17-8 (UL) - 1H-5 (UL1)
P17-1 (E) - Body ground
NG
Driver Side Junction Block
1H
L1
UL1
B079546E01
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DL–31
OK
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
DL
DL–32
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
All Doors LOCK / UNLOCK Functions do not Operate Via Door Control
Switch
DESCRIPTION
The main body ECU in the driver side junction block receives switch signals from the door control switch
and activates the door lock motors on each door according to the signals.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Driver Side Junction Block
Door Control Switch
L1
DL
UL1
B131924E02
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT DOOR CONTROL SWITCH
(a) Measure the resistance of the switch.
Standard resistance
Lock
Tester Connection
Unlock
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
3-6
Lock
Below 1 Ω
3-5
Unlock
3-6
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
No Pin (4)
B071970E14
OK
NG
REPLACE DOOR CONTROL SWITCH
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
2
DL–33
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SWITCH - DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK AND BODY
GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the D11 switch connector.
(b) Disconnect the 1H junction block connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Door Control Switch
D11
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D11-5 - 1H-14 (UL1)
Below 1 Ω
D11-6 - 1H-12 (L1)
NG
Driver Side Junction Block
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
DL
1H
L1
UL1
B079547E01
OK
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
DL–34
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
All Doors LOCK / UNLOCK Functions do not Operate Via Driver Side
Door Key Cylinder
DESCRIPTION
The main body ECU in the driver side junction block receives switch signals from the door key-linked door
lock / unlock switch and activates the door lock according to the signals.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Driver Side Junction Block
(Main Body ECU)
Front Door Lock LH
L2
DL
UL3
B131924E03
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (DOOR LOCK AND UNLOCK SWITCH)
(a) Check the DATA LIST for proper functioning of the door
lock and unlock switch.
Main body ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
DOR KEY SW-LOCK
Driver door lock/unlock switch
lock signal (key-linked lock
switch) / ON or OFF
ON: Driver side door key
cylinder is turned to LOCK
position
OFF: Driver side door key
cylinder is not turned to LOCK
position
-
DOR KEY SW-UN
Driver door lock/unlock switch
lock signal (key-linked unlock
switch) / ON or OFF
ON: Driver side door key
cylinder is turned to UNLOCK
position
OFF: Driver side door key
cylinder is not turned to
UNLOCK position
-
OK:
ON (door is locked/unlocked) appears on the
screen.
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
DL–35
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
NG
2
INSPECT FRONT DOOR LOCK ASSEMBLY LH (DOOR LOCK AND UNLOCK SWITCH)
(a) Measure the resistance of the door lock and unlock
switch.
Standard resistance
Lock
Tester Connection
Unlock
Condition
Specified Condition
7-9
Lock
Below 1 Ω
7 - 10
Unlock
7-9
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
7 - 10
NG
REPLACE FRONT DOOR LOCK ASSEMBLY
LH
DL
4 3 2 1
10 9 8 7 6 5
B127347E01
OK
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (MOTOR - JUNCTION BLOCK, ECU AND BODY GROUND)
Wire Harness Side
Driver Side Junction Block
(Main Body ECU)
Driver Side Junction Block
Front Door Lock LH
B7
D12
1H
L2
UL3
B131925E01
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Disconnect the D12 lock connector.
Disconnect the B7 ECU connector.
Disconnect the 1H junction block connector.
Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
DL–36
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D12-9 - 1H-16 (L2)
Below 1 Ω
D12-10 - B7-9 (UL3)
D12-7 - Body ground
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
DL
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DL–37
Only Driver Door LOCK / UNLOCK Functions do not Operate
DESCRIPTION
The main body ECU in the driver side junction block receives lock / unlock switch signals and activates
the door lock motor according to the signals.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Driver Side Junction Block
(Main Body ECU)
Front Door Lock LH
UL3
DL
L2
LSWD
ACTD
M
ACT+
B131937E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (DOOR LOCK MOTOR)
(a) Select the ACTIVE TEST, use the intelligent tester (with
CAN VIM) to generate a control command, and then
check that the door lock motor operates.
Main body ECU
Item
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
DOOR LOCK
Operate door lock motor for all doors
LOCK / UNLOCK
All doors are closed
DL–38
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
OK:
Doors can lock/unlock.
OK
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
NG
2
INSPECT FRONT DOOR LOCK LH (DOOR LOCK AND UNLOCK SWITCH AND POSITION
SWITCH)
(a) Measure the resistance of the door lock and unlock
switch and position switch.
Standard resistance
Door lock and unlock switch
Tester Connection
DL
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
7-9
Lock
Below 1 Ω
7 - 10
Unlock
7-9
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
7 - 10
Position switch
Tester Connection
7-8
Unlock
NG
Lock
B079551E05
OK
Lock
Below 1 Ω
Unlock
10 kΩ or higher
REPLACE FRONT DOOR LOCK LH
DL–39
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
3
INSPECT FRONT DOOR LOCK LH (DOOR LOCK MOTOR)
(a) Apply battery voltage to the door lock and check
operation of the door lock motor.
OK
Measurement Condition
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 4
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 1
Lock
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 1
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 4
Unlock
NG
REPLACE FRONT DOOR LOCK LH
Unlock
DL
Lock
B079551E05
OK
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (MOTOR - DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK, ECU AND BODY
GROUND)
Wire Harness Side
Driver Side Junction Block
(Main Body ECU)
Front Door Lock LH
Driver Side Junction Block
B7
D12
UL3
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
1H
ACTD
L2
Disconnect the D12 lock connector.
Disconnect the B7 ECU connector.
Disconnect the 1H junction block connector.
Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
ACT+
B131925E04
DL–40
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D12-4 - 1H-8 (ACT+)
Below 1 Ω
D12-1 - B7-5 (ACTD)
D12-8 - B7-25 (LSWD)
D12-9 - 1H-16 (L2)
D12-10 - B7-9 (UL3)
D12-7 - Body ground
NG
OK
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
DL
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DL–41
Only Passenger Door LOCK / UNLOCK Functions do not Operate
DESCRIPTION
The main body ECU in the driver side junction block receives lock / unlock switch signals and activates
the door lock motor according to the signals.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Driver Side Junction Block
(Main Body ECU)
Front Door Lock RH
LSWP
DL
ACTM
ACT+
B132155E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (DOOR LOCK MOTOR)
(a) Select the ACTIVE TEST, use the intelligent tester (with
CAN VIM) to generate a control command, and then
check that the power door lock operates.
Main body ECU
Item
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
DOOR LOCK
Operate door lock motor for all doors
LOCK / UNLOCK
All doors are closed
OK:
Doors can lock/unlock.
OK
NG
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
DL–42
2
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT FRONT DOOR LOCK RH (POSITION SWITCH)
(a) Measure the resistance of the position switch.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
7-8
NG
DL
Condition
Specified Condition
Lock
Below 1 Ω
Unlock
10 kΩ or higher
REPLACE FRONT DOOR LOCK RH
Unlock
Lock
B079247E07
OK
3
INSPECT FRONT DOOR LOCK RH (DOOR LOCK MOTOR)
(a) Apply battery voltage to the door lock and check
operation of the door lock motor.
OK
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 4
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 1
Lock
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 1
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 4
Unlock
NG
Unlock
Lock
B079247E07
OK
REPLACE FRONT DOOR LOCK RH
DL–43
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (MOTOR - DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK, ECU AND BODY
GROUND)
Wire Harness Side
Driver Side Junction Block
(Main Body ECU)
Front Door Lock RH
Driver Side Junction Block
B7
D13
1H
LSWP
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
ACT+
Disconnect the D13 lock connector.
Disconnect the B7 ECU connector.
Disconnect the 1H junction block connector.
Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D13-4 - 1H-17 (ACT+)
Below 1 Ω
D13-1 - 1H-9 (ACT-)
D13-7 - B7-10(LSWP)
D13-8 - Body ground
NG
OK
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
ACTB131925E03
DL
DL–44
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
Only Rear Door LH LOCK / UNLOCK Functions do not Operate
DESCRIPTION
The main body ECU in the driver side junction block receives lock / unlock switch signals and activates
the door lock motor according to the signals.
WIRING DIAGRAM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Driver Side Junction Block
(Main Body ECU)
Rear Door Lock LH
DL
LSWR
ACTM
ACT+
B132155E04
1
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (DOOR LOCK MOTOR)
(a) Select the ACTIVE TEST, use the intelligent tester (with
CAN VIM) to generate a control command, and then
check that the power door lock operates.
Main body ECU
Item
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
DOOR LOCK
Operate door lock motor for all doors
LOCK / UNLOCK
All doors are closed
OK:
Doors can lock / unlock.
NG
OK
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
DL–45
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
2
INSPECT REAR DOOR LOCK LH (POSITION SWITCH)
(a) Measure the resistance of the position switch.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
6-9
NG
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
Lock
Below 1 Ω
Unlock
10 kΩ or higher
REPLACE REAR DOOR LOCK LH
DL
Lock
Unlock
B079248E06
OK
3
INSPECT REAR DOOR LOCK LH (DOOR LOCK MOTOR)
(a) Apply battery voltage to the door lock and check
operation of the door lock motor.
OK
Measurement Condition
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 4
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 1
Lock
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 1
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 4
Unlock
NG
Lock
Unlock
B079248E06
OK
REPLACE REAR DOOR LOCK LH
DL–46
4
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (MOTOR - DRIVE SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK, ECU AND BODY
GROUND)
Wire Harness Side
Driver Side Junction Block
(Main Body ECU)
Driver Side Junction Block
Rear Door Lock LH
B5
1D
D14
ACT+
LSWR
DL
ACTB132156E01
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Disconnect the D14 lock connector.
Disconnect the B5 ECU connector.
Disconnect the 1D junction block connector.
Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D14-4 - 1D-3 (ACT+)
Below 1 Ω
D14-1 - 1D-4 (ACT-)
D14-6 - B5-10 (LSWR)
D14-9 - Body ground
NG
OK
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DL–47
Only Rear Door RH LOCK / UNLOCK Functions do not Operate
DESCRIPTION
The main body ECU in the driver side junction block receives lock / unlock switch signals and activates
the door lock motor according to the signals.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Driver Side Junction Block
(Main Body ECU)
Rear Door Lock RH
LSWR
DL
ACTM
ACT+
B132155E05
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (DOOR LOCK MOTOR)
(a) Select the ACTIVE TEST, use the intelligent tester (with
CAN VIM) to generate a control command, and then
check that the power door lock operates.
Main body ECU
Item
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
DOOR LOCK
Operate door lock motor for all doors
LOCK / UNLOCK
All doors are closed
OK:
Doors can lock / unlock.
NG
OK
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
DL–48
2
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT REAR DOOR LOCK RH (POSITION SWITCH)
(a) Measure the resistance of the position switch.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
6-9
NG
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
Lock
Below 1 Ω
Unlock
10 kΩ or higher
REPLACE REAR DOOR LOCK RH
DL
Unlock
Lock
B079249E04
OK
3
INSPECT REAR DOOR LOCK RH
(a) Apply battery voltage to the door lock and check
operation of the door lock motor.
OK
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 4
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 1
Lock
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 1
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 4
Unlock
NG
Unlock
Lock
B079249E04
OK
REPLACE REAR DOOR LOCK RH
DL–49
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (MOTOR - DRIVE SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK, ECU AND BODY
GROUND)
Wire Harness Side
Driver Side Junction Block
(Main Body ECU)
Driver Side Junction Block
Rear Door Lock RH
B5
D15
1H
LSWR
ACT+
ACTB132158E01
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Disconnect the D15 lock connector.
Disconnect the B5 ECU connector.
Disconnect the 1H junction block connector.
Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D15-4 - 1H-17 (ACT+)
Below 1 Ω
D15-1 - 1H-9 (ACT-)
D15-6 - B5-10 (LSWR
D15-9 - Body ground
NG
OK
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
DL
DL–50
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
Only Back Door LOCK / UNLOCK Functions do not Operate
DESCRIPTION
The driver side junction block (main body ECU) receives switch signals from the power window regulator
master switch and activates the luggage compartment door lock motor according to the signals.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Driver Side Junction Block
(Main Body ECU)
Back Door Lock
BCTY
BACT
M
DL
Back Door Opener Switch
BDSU
B132159E02
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (BACK DOOR OPENER SWITCH AND BACK
DOOR)
(a) Check the DATA LIST for proper functioning of back door
opener switch.
Main body ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
B DOR OPEN SW
Back door opener switch
signal / ON or OFF
OK: Back door opener switch
is pushed
OFF: Back door opener switch
is not pushed
-
OK:
ON (Back door opener switch is pushed) appears
on the screen.
(b) Check the DATA LIST for proper functioning of the back
door open judgment.
DL–51
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
Main body ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
TRNK/B DOR OPEN
Back door open judgment /
PROHIBT or PERMIT
PROHIBT: Back door opening
is impossible
PERMIT: Back door opening is
possible
-
OK:
PERMIT (Back door can be opened) appears on the
screen.
Result
Result
Proceed to
NG (back door opener switch)
A
NG (back door)
B
OK
C
B
Go to step 4
C
Go to step 5
DL
A
2
INSPECT BACK DOOR LOCK
(a) Remove the back door opener switch.
(b) Measure the resistance of the switch.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
Pushed (ON)
Below 1 Ω
Not pushed (OFF)
10 kΩ or higher
Pushed (ON)
NG
Not pushed (OFF)
B075486E01
OK
REPLACE BACK DOOR OPENER SWITCH
DL–52
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SWITCH - ECU AND BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the L4 switch connector.
(b) Disconnect the B7 ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Back Door Opener Switch
L4
L4-2 - B7-12 (BDSU)
Below 1 Ω
NG
B7
BDSU
B079557E01
OK
Specified Condition
L4-1 - Body ground
Driver Side Junction Block
(Main Body ECU)
DL
Tester Connection
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
4
DL–53
INSPECT BACK DOOR LOCK (DOOR LOCK MOTOR)
(a) Check operation of the back door lock.
(1) Using a screwdriver, move the latch to the full-latch
position.
(2) Apply battery voltage to the door lock and check
operation the latch.
OK
Measurement Condition
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 4
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 3
Latch turns to open-latch position
NG
REPLACE BACK DOOR LOCK
Position
DL
Full-latch
Open-latch
B079562E01
OK
DL–54
5
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT BACK DOOR LOCK (COURTESY SWITCH)
(a) Measure the resistance of the switch.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
1-2
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
Open-latch
Below 1 Ω
Half-latch
Full-latch
10 kΩ or higher
Over-latch
NG
Position
DL
Open-latch
Half-latch
Full-latch
Over-latch
B079558E01
OK
REPLACE BACK DOOR LOCK
DL–55
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
6
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (MOTOR - DRIVE SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK, ECU AND BODY
GROUND)
Wire Harness Side
Driver Side Junction Block
(Main Body ECU)
Back Door Lock
Driver Side Junction Block
B7
L3
1D
BCTY
BACT
DL
B132160E01
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Disconnect the L3 lock connector.
Disconnect the B7 ECU connector.
Disconnect the 1D junction block connector.
Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
L3-2 - 1D-7 (BCTY)
Below 1 Ω
L3-4 - B7-1 (BACT)
L3-1 - Body ground
L3-3 - Body ground
NG
OK
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
DL–56
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
Key Lock-in Prevention Function does not Work Properly (Manual
Operation and Operation Interlocked with Key are Active)
DESCRIPTION
To prevent the key from being locked in the vehicle, the door control relay prevents doors from being
locked by monitoring 2 switches: 1) the unlock warning switch, which turns ON when the key is inserted
into the key slot; and 2) the driver side courtesy light switch, which turns ON when the driver side door is
opened.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Transponder Key ECU
Key Slot
DL
CUWS
GND
MPX1
Driver Side Junction Block
(Main Body ECU)
Front Door Courtesy Light Switch LH
MPX2
DCTY
GND
B132161E02
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (FRONT DOOR COURTESY LIGHT SWITCH LH)
(a) Check the DATA LIST for proper function of the driver
side door courtesy switch.
DL–57
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
Main body ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
D DOR CTY SW
Driver side door courtesy
switch signal / ON or OFF
ON: Driver side door is open
OFF: Driver side door is closed
-
OK:
ON (driver side door is open) appears on the
screen.
OK
Go to step 4
NG
2
INSPECT FRONT DOOR COURTESY LIGHT SWITCH LH
Not Pushed (ON)
Pushed (OFF)
Body Ground
(a) Remove the front door courtesy light switch.
(b) Measure the resistance of the switch
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
1 - Body ground
Not pushed (ON)
Below 1 Ω
Pushed (OFF)
10 kΩ or higher
NG
B058556E16
REPLACE FRONT DOOR COURTESY LIGHT
SWITCH LH
OK
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SWITCH - DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK AND BODY
GROUND)
Wire Harness Side
Front Door Courtesy Light Switch LH
D7
(a) Disconnect the D7 switch connector.
(b) Disconnect the 1D junction block connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D7-1 - 1D-21 (DCTY)
Below 1 Ω
NG
Driver Side Junction Block
1D
DCTY
B132162E01
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
DL
DL–58
DOOR LOCK – POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
OK
4
INSPECT KEY SLOT
(a) Measure the resistance of the key slot.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
2-4
Key in key slot
Below 1 Ω
No key in key slot
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPLACE KEY SLOT
B079242E01
OK
DL
5
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SLOT - ECU)
(a) Disconnect the K2 key slot connector.
(b) Disconnect the T5 ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Key Slot
K2
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
K2-4 (KSW1) - T5-5 (CUWS)
Below 1 Ω
K2-2 (COM) - Body ground
KSW1
COM
Transponder Key ECU
NG
T5
CUWS
B080183E01
OK
REPLACE TRANSPONDER KEY ECU ASSEMBLY
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
DL–55
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK
CONTROL SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key
System)
PRECAUTION
NOTICE:
For initialization:
When disconnecting the cable from the negative (-)
battery terminal, initialize the following system after the
cable is reconnected.
System Name
Power Window Control System
See procedure
IN-32
For hybrid system activation:
When the warning light is illuminated or the battery has
been disconnected and reconnected, pressing the power
switch may not start the system on the first try. If so,
press the power switch again.
DL
DL–56
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
PARTS LOCATION
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK BUZZER
DOOR CONTROL RECEIVER
FRONT DOOR COURTESY
LIGHT SWITCH RH
KEY SLOT
- HALFWAY SWITCH
FRONT DOOR LOCK RH
CERTIFICATION ECU
REAR DOOR COURTESY
LIGHT SWITCH RH
FRONT DOOR
LOCK LH
REAR DOOR LOCK RH
DL
DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION
BLOCK
- MAIN BODY ECU
- TURN SIGNAL FLASHER
RELAY
REAR DOOR COURTESY
LIGHT SWITCH LH
FRONT DOOR COURTESY
LIGHT SWITCH LH
REAR DOOR LOCK LH
BACK DOOR LOCK
- BACK DOOR
COURTESY SWITCH
BACK DOOR OPENER SWITCH
B127172E02
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
DL–57
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
Key (Door Control Transmitter)
Door Control Receiver
Certification
ECU
BEAN
Key Slot (Halfway Switch)
BERKES
DL
Front Door Lock (LH, RH)
Rear Door Lock (LH, RH)
Front Door Courtesy Light
Switch (LH, RH)
Back Door Lock
Wireless Door Lock Buzzer
Rear Door Courtesy Light
Switch (LH, RH)
Main Body
ECU
Flasher Relay
Horn Relay
Back Door Courtesy Light
Switch
Headlight Relay
Taillight Relay
Door Lock Position Switch
Interior Relay
B127173E02
DL–58
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
2.
DL
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DESCRIPTION
(a) This system locks and unlocks the vehicle's doors
remotely. The wireless door lock control system has
the following features:
• The door control receiver performs the code
identification process and the main body ECU
operates the door lock control. A serial data link
is provided for communication between the door
control receiver and main body ECU.
• A key-integrated type transmitter is used and it
contains the following 3 switches: the LOCK
switch, UNLOCK switch and PANIC switch.
• An LED is mounted on the transmitter to show if
the battery is depleted.
FUNCTION OF MAIN COMPONENTS
Components
Functions
•
•
Door control transmitter
•
Contains LOCK, UNLOCK and PANIC switches
Transmits faint electric wave (recognition codes and function
codes) to door control receiver
Illumination indicator light (LED) during transmission
Door control receiver
Receives faint electric waves (recognition code and function codes)
and outputs them as code data to main body ECU
Key slot (halfway switch)
Detects if key slot has key or not
Front door courtesy light switch
Rear door courtesy light switch
Back door courtesy light switch
Turns on when door is open and turns off when door is closed.
Outputs door status (open or closed) to main body ECU.
Door lock position switch
Transmits door lock positions of each door to main body ECU
3.
SYSTEM FUNCTION
(a) Door lock/unlock function:
With no key in the key slot (halfway switch is off)
and all courtesy light switches off, pressing the door
control transmitter's LOCK/UNLOCK switch causes
the transmitter to output electric waves which are
input to the door control receiver. The door control
receiver converts these waves into code data in its
internal high frequency circuit, and outputs the code
data to the main body ECU. The door control
receiver and certification ECU evaluate the code
data (recognition codes and function codes) and
output the evaluation results to the main body ECU.
Upon receiving a door lock/unlock request signal,
the main body ECU outputs a door lock/unlock
control signal to each door lock. Each door lock then
locks/unlocks its respective door and turns on/off its
door lock position switch according to the signal.
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
DL–59
(b) Answer-back function:
The main body ECU receives the door unlock
detection switch's on/off signals and uses these
signals to confirm if door control operation has
completed. The main body ECU then outputs the
hazard warning light's output control signal to flash
the hazard warning light as an answer-back and
wireless door lock buzzer signals to cause the
wireless door buzzer to sound as an answer-back.
(c) Panic function:
When the door control transmitter's PANIC switch is
pressed, the door control receiver and certification
ECU evaluate the code data (recognition codes and
function codes) from the door control transmitter in
the same way as when the LOCK/UNLOCK switch
is pressed. Upon receiving a theft deterrent alarm
control signal from the certification ECU, the main
body ECU actuates a built-in relay to causer the
security horn to sound, as well as transmit several
kinds of warning signals (hazard warning light
control signal, vehicle horn warning control signal,
headlight warning signal and taillight warning signal)
in order to output a theft deterrent alarm.
(d) The wireless door lock control system has the
following functions.
Function
Outline
All door unlock function
Pressing LOCK switch locks all doors
All door unlock function (for 2 step unlock operation)
Pressing UNLOCK switch once will unlock driver side door. Pressing
UNLOCK switch again within 3 seconds will unlock remaining doors.
•
Answer-back function
•
Hazard warning lights flash once when doors are locked, and
flash twice when doors are unlock to inform that operation has
been completed
Wireless door lock buzzer sounds once when doors are locked
and sounds twice when doors are unlocked to inform that
operation has been completed
Panic function
Holding down PANIC switch sets off theft deterrent alarm, which
consists of sounding horn, and flashing headlights, taillights and
hazard warning lights
Automatic lock function
If no doors are opened within 30 seconds after they are unlocked by
wireless door lock remote control, all doors will lock again
automatically
Repeat function
If door is not locked in response to locking operation of transmitter,
main body ECU will output lock signal after 1 second
Illuminated entry function
With all doors locked, pressing door unlock switch causes room light
to illuminate simultaneously with unlocking operation
Security function
Sends signal as rolling code
Transmitter recognition code registration function
Enables 4 modes for registering (writing and storing) transmitter
recognition codes in EEPROM, which is built into main body ECU
Self-diagnosis
If system has malfunction, main body ECU sets DTC in its memory
DL
DL–60
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
• Use these procedures to troubleshoot the wireless door
lock control system.
• *: Use the intelligent tester.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
INSPECT BATTERY VOLTAGE
Standard voltage:
11 to 14 V
If the voltage is below 11 V, recharge or replace the battery
before proceeding
DL
NEXT
3
INSPECT COMMUNICATION FUNCTION OF LARGE-SCALE MULTIPLEX
COMMUNICATION SYSTEM (BEAN)*
(a) Using the intelligent tester, check if the Multiplex
Communication System (MPX) is functioning normally
(see page MP-16).
Result:
Result
Proceed to
MPX DTC is not output
A
MPX DTC is output
B
B
Go to MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION
SYSTEM
A
4
CHECK FOR DTC*
(a) Check for DTCs (see page DL-107) and note any codes
that are output.
(b) Delete the DTC.
(c) Recheck for DTCs. Try to prompt the DTC by simulating
the original activity that the DTC suggests.
Result:
Result
Proceed to
DTC does not reoccur
A
DTC reoccurs
B
B
Go to step 7
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
DL–61
A
5
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Result:
Result
Proceed to
Fault is not listed in problem symptoms
table
A
Fault is listed in problem symptoms
table
B
B
Go to step 7
A
6
OVERALL ANALYSIS AND TROUBLESHOOTING*
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
NEXT
7
ADJUST, REPAIR OR REPLACE
NEXT
8
NEXT
END
CONFIRMATION TEST
Operation check (see page DL-61)
DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST (see page DL-70)
Terminals of ECU (see page DL-66)
Inspection (see page DL-217)
DL
DL–62
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
OPERATION CHECK
1.
DL
2.
NOTES WHEN CHECKING
(a) Wireless door LOCK/UNLOCK function:
This function operates only when the following 4
conditions are met.
• No key is inserted into the key slot.
• All the doors are closed.
• The power door lock control system is
functioning normally.
• Key is not within the key detection area.
HINT:
The UNLOCK function operates even when one of
the doors is open.
(b) Panic function:
This wireless control function operates only when
the following condition is met.
• The power switch must be OFF.
HINT:
The key can be inserted. However the power switch
must be OFF.
(c) The wireless transmitter operating range differs
depending on the situation.
• The operating range differs depending on the
user, the way the transmitter is held and the
location.
• In certain areas, the operating range will be
reduced due to the vehicle body shape and the
influence of the surrounding environment.
• Since the transmitter uses faint electric waves,
the operating range might be shortened if noise
or strong electric waves occur in the area where
the transmitter is used. Or, the transmitter may
not function.
• When the battery weakens, the operating range
is reduced or the transmitter may not function.
HINT:
If the transmitter has been left in a place that is
exposed to direct sunlight, such as on the
instrument panel, the battery may weaken or other
problem may occur.
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL FUNCTIONS
HINT:
• The switches described below transmit signals and
are built into the door control transmitter.
• The operating range must be taken into account while
checks are being made.
(a) Make sure the vehicle is in a condition where the
wireless door lock control function can be operated
(see above).
(b) Check basic functions:
• Check that the transmitter's LED illuminates 3
times when each switch is pressed 3 times.
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
(h)
DL–63
HINT:
If the LED does not illuminate when the switch has
been pressed 3 times or more, the battery may be
depleted.
• Check that all doors (including the back door)
lock when the LOCK switch is pressed.
• Check that only the driver side door unlocks
when the UNLOCK switch is pressed once, and
that the remaining doors unlock when the
UNLOCK switch is pressed again within 3
seconds.
Check the chattering prevention function:
• Check that pressing a switch will result in the
switch's operation occurring only once; and when
the switch is held down, the operation is not
repeated continuously. Also, make sure that
when the switch is pressed at intervals of
approximately 1 second, the switch's operation
activates once for every press of the switch.
Check the automatic locking function:
• Check that if all of the doors are unlocked with
the UNLOCK switch and none of the doors are
opened or locked within approximately 30
seconds, the door automatically relocks.
• Check that if all of the doors are unlocked with
the UNLOCK switch and a door is opened or
locked within approximately 30 seconds, the
automatic locking function does not operate.
Check the switch operation fail-safe function:
• Check that the doors cannot be locked by a
transmitter switch while the key is in the key slot.
However, this does not apply when the system is
in recognition code registration mode.
Check the operation stop function when a door is
open or not completely closed:
• Check that if a door is open or not completely
closed, the doors cannot be locked by the LOCK
switch.
Check the repeat function:
• Check that if the LOCK switch is pressed while
the movement of the driver side door control
knob (in the unlocked state) is restricted, the
repeat function attempts to lock all of the doors
again 2 seconds later.
Check the answer-back function:
• When the LOCK switch is pressed, confirm the
simultaneous occurrence of all the hazard
warning lights flashing once, the buzzer sounding
once and all the doors locking.
• When the UNLOCK switch is pressed, confirm
the simultaneous occurrence of all the hazard
warning lights flashing twice, the buzzer
sounding twice and the driver side door
unlocking.
DL
DL–64
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
(i)
(j)
DL
• When UNLOCK switch is pressed again within 3
seconds, conform the simultaneous occurrence
of all the hazard warning lights flashing twice, the
buzzer sounding twice and all the doors
unlocking.
Check the illuminated entry function:
• When all the doors are locked, pressing the
UNLOCK switch causes the room light (when the
light switch is in the DOOR position) to illuminate
simultaneously with the unlock operation.
• Check that the room light turns off in
approximately 15 seconds if doors have not been
opened.
Check the panic function:
(1) Check that if PANIC switch is held down for 0.8
seconds or more, the theft deterrent alarm
function sounds the horn and flashes the
headlights and taillights for 60 seconds. And,
with the theft alarm function active, check if
pressing any switch on the transmitter causes
the horn to stop sounding and the headlights
and taillights to stop flashing.
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
DL–65
CUSTOMIZE PARAMETERS
1.
CUSTOMIZING FUNCTION WITH INTELLIGENT
TESTER (REFERENCE)
HINT:
The following items can be customized.
NOTICE:
• When the customer requests a change in a function,
first make sure that the functions can be customized.
• Be sure to record the current settings before
customizing.
• When troubleshooting a function, first make sure that
the function is set to the default setting.
Wireless door lock control system:
Display (Items)
Default
Contents
Setting
ON
If door is not completely closed
and transmitter LOCK switch is
pressed, this function sounds
buzzer for 10 seconds
ON / OFF
ON
Function that makes wireless
buzzer sound for answer-back
when transmitter LOCK/UNLOCK
switch is pressed
ON / OFF
ON
Function that operates theft
deterrent alarm when transmitter
PANIC switch transmitter is held
0.8 seconds.
ON / OFF
UNLOCK/2OPER (Wireless
unlock operated twice)
ON
Function that unlocks driver side
door when UNLOCK switch on
transmitter is pressed once, and
unlocks all doors when pressed
twice. If set to OFF, pressing
UNLOCK switch once unlocks all
doors.
ON / OFF
AUTO LOCK DELAY (Auto lock
time)
30s
This function controls amount of
time from unlocking doors to
automatic re-locking function
30s / 60s
ON
When LOCK switch on
transmitter is pressed, this
function illuminates all hazard
warning lights once. When
UNLOCK switch is pressed, all
hazard warning lights illuminate
twice
ON / OFF
OPEN DOOR WARN (Door ajar
warning function
WIRLS BUZZ OPER (Buzzer
answer-back for wireless door
lock operation)
ALARM FUNCTION (Panic
function)
HAZARD ANS BACK (Hazard
answer-back for wireless door
lock operation)
DL
DL–66
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
• Use the table below to help determine the cause of the
problem symptom. The potential causes of the symptoms
are listed in order of probability in the "Suspected area"
column of the table. Check each symptom by checking the
suspected areas in the order they are listed. Replace parts
as necessary.
• Inspect the fuses and relays related to this system before
inspecting the suspected areas below.
Wireless door lock control system:
Symptom
Only wireless control function is inoperative
DL
No answer-back
Suspected area
See page
1. Transmitter battery
DL-79
2. Door control transmitter
DL-79
3. Door control receiver
DL-79
4. Key slot
DL-79
5. Wire harness
DL-79
6. Driver side junction block (main body ECU)
DL-79
7. Certification ECU
DL-79
8. Lighting system
DL-79
1. Wireless door lock buzzer
DL-76
2. Lighting system
DL-76
3. Wire harness
DL-76
4. Driver side junction block (main body ECU)
DL-76
DL–67
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
CHECK DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK (MAIN
BODY ECU)
Vehicle Rear Side
1D
Vehicle Front Side
B7
1A
1E
1B
1J
DL
1L
1D
1A
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
8
9
10
11
23
24
25
26
9
10
11
12
27
28
29
30
12
13
14
15
27
28
29
30
13
14
15
16
17
18
31
32
33
34
35
36
1E
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
9
10
11
12
25
26
27
28
13
14
15
16
29
30
31
32
B7
6
5
4
3
2
1
17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7
26 25 24 23
22 21 20 19 18
1L
10 1112131415161718
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
1B
1
1J
3 2
1
8 7 6 5 4
B127174E01
DL–68
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
(a) Disconnect the 1A, 1B, 1D, 1E and 1J junction block
connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance and voltage of the wire
harness side connectors.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
GND (1E-17) - Body
ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground
SIG (1B-1) - Body ground
W - Body ground
Ignition power supply
ACC (1J-5) - Body ground
G - Body ground
Ignition power supply
ECUB (1A-30) - Body
ground
R - Body ground
+B (ECUB) power supply
KSW (1E-23) - Body
ground
Y - Body ground
KSW (1E-26) - Body
ground
DL
Terminal Description
Key unlock warning switch
input
DCTY (1D-21) - Body
ground
V - Body ground
Driver side door courtesy
switch input
PCTY (1D-24) - Body
ground
BR - Body ground
Passenger side door
courtesy switch input
BCTY (1D-7) - Body
ground
R- Body ground
Back door courtesy switch
input
Condition
Specified Condition
Always
Below 1 Ω
Power switch OFF
Below 1 V
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
Power switch OFF
Below 1 V
Power switch ON (ACC)
10 to 14 V
Always
10 to 14 V
No key in key slot
10 kΩ or higher
Key inserted
Below 1 Ω
No key in key slot
10 kΩ or higher
Key inserted
Below 1 Ω
Driver side door closed
10 kΩ or higher
Driver side door open
Below 1 Ω
Passenger side door
closed
10 kΩ or higher
Passenger side door open
Below 1 Ω
Back door closed
10 kΩ or higher
Back door open
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
(c) Reconnect the 1A, 1B, 1D, 1E and 1J junction block
connectors.
(d) Measure the voltage of the connectors.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
HAZ (1L-17) - Body
ground
RDA (B7-23) - Body
ground
Wiring Color
Y - Body ground
L- Body ground
Terminal Description
Hazard warning light drive
Door control receiver input
2.
Condition
Specified Condition
Answer-back OFF
Below 1 V
Answer-back ON
Pulse generation
Transmitter switch OFF
(power switch OFF and all
door closed)
Below 1 V
Transmitter switch ON
(power switch OFF and all
door closed)
Pulse generation
If the result is not as specified, the junction block
(ECU) have a malfunction.
CHECK CERTIFICATION ECU
S11
17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10
9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18
B126057E01
(a) Disconnect the S11 ECU connector.
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
DL–69
(b) Measure the resistance and voltage of the wire
harness side connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
E (S11-17) - Body ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always
+B1 (S11-1) - E (S11-17)
R - W-B
Battery power supply
Always
10 to 14 V
Power switch OFF
Below 1 V
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
IG (S11-18) - E (S11-17)
B - W-B
Ignition power supply
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
(c) Reconnect the S11 ECU connector.
(d) Measure the voltage of the connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
RSSI (S11-11) - E (S1117)
RDA (S11-10) - E (S11-17)
CLG1 (S11-13) - E (S1117)
SEL1 (S11-23) - E (S1117)
Wiring Color
V - W-B
GR - W-B
P - W-B
Y - W-B
Terminal Description
Door control receiver
output signal
Door control receiver input
signal
Driver door oscillator
sensor signal
Driver door oscillator
sensor signal
Condition
Specified Condition
Transmitter switch OFF
(power switch OFF and all
doors closed)
5 to 0 V
Transmitter switch ON
(power switch OFF and all
doors closed)
Below 1 V
Transmitter switch OFF
(power switch OFF and all
doors closed)
Below 1 V
Transmitter switch ON
(power switch OFF and all
doors closed)
Alternating between 6 to 7
V and below 1 V
Power switch OFF (all
doors open with key from
outside vehicle)
Pulse generation
Power switch ON (IG) (all
doors open with key from
outside vehicle)
No pulse
Key placed at least 3 m
(9.84 ft.) from driver door
10 to 14 V
Place key close to front
door outside handle RH
Below 1 V
DL
If the result is not as specified, the ECU may have a
malfunction.
DL–70
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
1.
DESCRIPTION
(a) Wireless door lock control system data and the
Diagnosis Trouble Codes (DTCs) can be read
through the Data Link Connector 3 (DLC3). When
the system seems to be malfunctioning, use the
intelligent tester to check for malfunctions and
perform repairs.
2.
CHECK DLC3
(a) The vehicle uses the ISO 15765-4 communication
protocol. The terminal arrangement of the DLC3
complies with SAE J1962 and matches the ISO
15765-4 format.
CG SG CANH SIL
CANL
DL
BAT
H100769E16
Symbols (Terminal No.)
SIL (7) - SG (5)
Terminal Description
Bus "+" line
CG (4) - Body ground
Chassis ground
SG (5) - Body ground
Signal ground
BAT (16) - Body ground
Battery positive
Condition
During transmission
Always
Below 1 Ω
11 to 14 V
54 to 69 Ω
CANH (6) - CANL (14)
CANH (6) - Battery positive
HIGH-level CAN bus line
CANH (6) - CG (4)
1 kΩ or higher
Power switch OFF
CANL (14) - Battery positive
CANL (14) - CG (4)
Specified Condition
Pulse generation
LOW-level CAN bus line
1 kΩ or higher
1 MΩ or higher
1 MΩ or higher
If the result is not as specified, the DLC3 may have
a malfunction. Repair or replace the harness and
connector.
HINT:
Connect the cable of the intelligent tester (with CAN
VIM) to the DLC3, turn the power switch ON (IG)
and attempt to use the tester. If the screen displays
the message UNABLE TO CONNECT TO
VEHICLE, there is a problem either with the vehicle
or with the tester.
• If communication is normal when the tester is
connected to another vehicle, inspect the DLC3
of the original vehicle.
• If communication is still not possible when the
tester is connected to another vehicle, the
problem is probably in the tester itself. Consult
the Service Department listed in the tester's
instruction manual.
Intelligent Tester
DLC3
CAN VIM
B126098E01
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
DL–71
DTC CHECK / CLEAR
Intelligent Tester
1.
2.
DLC3
CAN VIM
CHECK DTC
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the CAN VIM. Then
connect the CAN VIM to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Read the DTCs by following the directions on the
tester screen.
CLEAR DTC
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Erase the DTCs by following the directions on the
tester screen.
B126098E01
DL
DL–72
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST
1.
READ DATA LIST
HINT:
Using the intelligent tester's DATA LIST allows switch,
actuator and other item values to be read without
removing any parts. Reading the DATA LIST early in
troubleshooting is one way to save time.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Read the DATA LIST.
Main body ECU:
Item
DL
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
D DOR CTY SW
Driver side door courtesy switch
signal / ON or OFF
ON: Driver side door is open
OFF: Driver side door is closed
-
P DOR CTY SW
Passenger side door courtesy
switch signal / ON or OFF
ON: Passenger side door is open
OFF: Passenger side door is
closed
-
Rr DOR CTY SW
Rear door courtesy switch signal /
ON or OFF
ON: Either right or left door is
open
OFF: Both right and left doors are
closed
-
D LOCK POS SW
Driver side door lock position
switch signal / ON or OFF
ON: Driver side door lock is in
unlock position
OFF: Driver side door lock is in
lock position
-
P LOCK POS SW
Passenger side door lock position
switch signal / ON or OFF
ON: Passenger side door lock is
in unlock position
OFF: Passenger side door lock is
in lock position
-
Rr LOCK POS SW
Rear door lock position switch
signal / ON or OFF
ON: Rear door lock is in unlock
position
OFF: Rear door lock is in lock
position
-
REGIST ID CODE
Number of registered ID / Min. 0,
Max. 4
Number of registered ID codes
-
Transponder key ECU:
Item
KEY UNLK WRN SW
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Halfway switch signal / ON or
OFF
2.
Normal Condition
ON: Key is in key slot.
OFF: No key is in key slot.
Diagnostic Note
-
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST
HINT:
Performing the intelligent tester's ACTIVE TEST allows
relay, VSV, actuator, and other items to be operated
without removing any parts. Performing the ACTIVE
TEST early in troubleshooting is one way to save time.
The DATA LIST can be displayed during the ACTIVE
TEST.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
DL–73
(c) Perform the ACTIVE TEST according to the display
on the tester.
Main body ECU:
Item
HAZARD
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
Turns turn signal flasher relay ON / OFF
-
TRUNK/BDOR OPEN
Operate back door motor ON / OFF
-
DOOR LOCK
Operate door lock motor for all doors OFF /
LOCK / UNLOCK
All doors are closed
DL
DL–74
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
Wireless door lock control system:
DTC No.
B1242
DL
Detection Item
Trouble Area
See page
Wireless Door Lock Tuner Circuit
Malfunction
- Wire Harness
- Door control receiver
- Certification ECU
- Driver side junction block (main
body ECU)
DL-72
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
DTC
B1242
DL–75
Wireless Door Lock Tuner Circuit Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
This DTC is detected when a RDA signal is not input to the door control receiver through the certification
ECU within 1 second after the main body ECU outputs a PRG signal.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Within 1 second after PRG signal is output
from body ECU during self-diagnostic mode,
corresponding RDA signal is not input.
B1242
•
•
•
•
Door control receiver
Wire harness
Certification ECU
Driver side junction block (main body
ECU)
WIRING DIAGRAM
DL
Door Control Receiver
GND
RSSI
GND DATA
+5
Certification ECU
Main Body ECU
PRG
PRG
RDA RDA3
RDA
RSSI
RCO
E
B127175E02
DL–76
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (DOOR CONTROL RECEIVER - CERTIFICATION ECU AND BODY
GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the D4 receiver connector.
(b) Disconnect the S11 ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Door Control Receiver
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D4-4 (DATA) - S11-10 (RDA)
D4
D4-3 (RSSI) - S11-11 (RSSI)
1 2 3 4 5
GND
GND RSSI
D4-5 (+5) - S11-12 (RCO)
D4-2 (GND) - Body ground
+5
DATA
D4-1 (GND) - Body ground
D4-4 (DATA) or S11-10 (RDA) - Body
ground
DL
D4-3 (RSSI) or S11-11 (RSSI) - Body
ground
S11
NG
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40
RDA
RSSI RCO
B127176E03
OK
10 kΩ or higher
D4-5 (+5) or S11-12 (RCO) - Body
ground
Certification ECU
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
Below 1 Ω
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
2
DL–77
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (CERTIFICATION ECU - MAIN BODY ECU AND BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the S11 and B7 ECU connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Tester Connection
Certification ECU
S11
S11-29 (RDA3) - B7-23 (RDA)
S11-28 (PRG) - B7-24 (PRG)
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40
S11-29 (RDA3) or B7-23 (RDA) - Body
ground
S11-28 (PRG) or B7-24 (PRG) - Body
ground
PRG
RDA3
NG
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
10 kΩ or higher
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
DL
Body ECU
S7
1
2
3
4
5
6
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
18 19 20 21
22 23 24 25 26
RDA
PRG
B127177E02
OK
3
CHECK DOOR CONTROL RECEIVER (OPERATION)
(a) Temporarily replace the door control receiver with a new
or normally functioning one.
(b) Check that no DTC is output.
OK:
DTC is not output.
OK
END (DOOR CONTROL RECEIVER IS
DEFECTIVE)
NG
4
CHECK CERTIFICATION ECU (OPERATION)
(a) Temporarily replace the certification ECU with a new or
normally functioning one.
(b) Check that no DTC is output.
OK:
DTC is not output.
DL–78
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
NG
OK
END (CERTIFICATION ECU IS DEFECTIVE)
DL
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
ASSEMBLY (MAIN BODY ECU)
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
DL–79
No Answer-back
DESCRIPTION
In some cases, wireless door lock control functions are normal but the hazard warning lights and / or
wireless door lock buzzer answer-back function(s) is not. In such cases, the main body ECU's hazard
warning lights and wireless door lock buzzer signal outputs may be malfunctioning.
NOTICE:
Troubleshooting should be started after confirming that the answer-back function has been
switched ON.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Wireless Door Lock Buzzer
Main Body ECU
DL
BUZ
Turn Signal Flasher Relay
EHW
HAZ
Hazard Warning Signal Switch
B127184E02
DL–80
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL FUNCTION
(a) Check the wireless door lock control function by
operating the transmitter switch.
Result:
Result
Proceed to
Wireless door lock functions are normal but hazard warning lights
answer-back does not occur
A
Wireless door lock functions are normal but wireless door lock buzzer
answer-back does not occur
B
Doors cannot be locked and unlocked with transmitter
C
B
Go to step 4
C
DL
GO TO PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
A
2
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (TURN SIGNAL FLASHER RELAY)
(a) Select the ACTIVE TEST, use the intelligent tester to
generate a control command, and then check that the
hazard warning lights flash.
Main body ECU:
Item
HAZARD
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
Turn signal flasher relay ON / OFF
-
OK:
Turn signal flasher relay turns ON / OFF.
OK
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
ASSEMBLY (MAIN BODY ECU)
NG
3
CHECK HAZARD WARNING LIGHT
(a) Check that the hazard warning lights flash continuously
when the hazard warning signal switch is pressed.
OK:
Hazard warning lights flash continuously.
NG
GO TO LIGHTING SYSTEM
OK
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK ASSEMBLY (MAIN BODY ECU)
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
4
DL–81
INSPECT WIRELESS DOOR LOCK BUZZER
2
(a) Measure the resistance between terminals 1 and 2 of the
buzzer.
Standard resistance:
Approximately 1 kΩ
NOTICE:
• The buzzer circuit is built into the main body ECU,
not into the buzzer itself.
• When battery voltage is directly applied to the
buzzer, the buzzer does not sound.
1
B127185
NG
REPLACE WIRELESS DOOR LOCK BUZZER
OK
5
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (WIRELESS DOOR LOCK BUZZER - MAIN BODY ECU AND
BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the W6 buzzer connector.
(b) Disconnect the B6 ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Wireless Door Lock Buzzer
1
W6
Tester Connection
2
W6-1 - B6-13 (BUZ)
W6-2 - Body ground
W6-1 - Body ground
NG
Main Body ECU
B6
1
2 3
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
10 kΩ or higher
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
4
5 6 7 8 9 10
11 12 13 14 15 16
BZR
B127186E02
OK
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK ASSEMBLY (MAIN BODY ECU)
DL
DL–82
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
Only Wireless Door Lock Control Function does not Operate
DESCRIPTION
The door control receiver receives signals from the transmitter and sends these signals to the main body
ECU through the certification ECU. The main body ECU then controls all doors by sending LOCK/
UNLOCK signals to each door lock.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Door Control Receiver
DL
Certification ECU
Main Body ECU
GND RSSI
RSSI
PRG
PRG
GND DATA
RDA RDA3
RDA
RCO
KSW
+5
KSW
E
Key Slot
COM
KSW1
GND
B127178E02
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL FUNCTIONS
(a) Refer to operation check (see page DL-61).
OK
NG
NORMAL
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
2
DL–83
CHECK THAT TRANSMITTER LED LIGHTS UP
(a) Check that the transmitter's LED illuminates 3 times
when the switch is pressed 3 times.
OK:
Transmitter's LED illuminates 3 times when switch
is pressed 3 times.
NG
Go to step 4
OK
3
CHECK WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL FUNCTIONS (STANDARD OPERATION)
(a) Check standard UNLOCK/LOCK switch operation.
NOTICE:
Standardized test procedure:
Press the transmitter switch for 1 second, directing
the transmitter to the driver side door outside handle
from a distance of 1 m (3.28 ft.). The transmitter
should be pointed directly at the handle, i.e. at a 90°
angle to the vehicle body.
OK:
Doors can be locked and unlocked with transmitter
switches.
NG
Go to step 5
OK
REPLACE DOOR CONTROL TRANSMITTER
4
CHECK TRANSMITTER BATTERY (OPERATION)
(a) Temporarily replace the transmitter battery with a new or
normally functioning one (see page DL-215).
(b) Check that the doors can be locked and unlocked by
using the transmitter LOCK/UNLOCK switch.
OK:
Doors can be locked and unlocked with
transmitter.
NG
OK
END (TRANSMITTER BATTERY IS DEFECTIVE)
REPLACE DOOR CONTROL TRANSMITTER
DL
DL–84
5
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
SWITCH TO SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
DL
Room Light
a: 0.13 sec.
b: 0.15 sec.
ON
OFF
a
b
(a) Switch to self-diagnostic mode using the intelligent
tester.
(1) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(2) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and push the
intelligent tester main switch ON.
HINT:
Please refer to the intelligent tester operator's
manual for further details.
(b) Switch to self-diagnostic mode by operating the key.
(1) Put the vehicle under the vehicle's initial condition
(see page DL-61), insert the key into the key slot
and remove it.
(2) Within 5 seconds of removing the key (step above),
insert the key into the key slot. Then turn the power
switch ON (IG) and OFF.
(3) Within 30 seconds of switching the power switch
OFF again (step above), perform the following 9
times:
Turn the power switch ON (IG) and OFF*.
NOTICE:
If the change to self-diagnostic mode has failed,
the system will return to normal mode.
HINT:
• Turning the power switch ON (IG) after step* has
been completed will end self-diagnostic mode.
• Do not lock or unlock doors during self-diagnostic
mode.
(c) Check that the system has switched to self-diagnostic
mode by checking the flashes of the room light (dome
light or key slot light). Compare the flash patterns of the
room light to the timing chart on the illustration.
OK:
Flash patterns of room light should be the same as
that shown in timing chart on illustration.
NG
Go to step 9
B052341E09
OK
6
CHECK BY SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
(a) Inspect the diagnosis outputs when the door control
transmitter switch is held down. The diagnosis outputs
can be checked by the flash patterns of the room light.
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
DL–85
Flash Pattern of Room Light
Normal Wave of LOCK Switch
ON
OFF
T1
T3
Normal Wave of UNLOCK Switch
DL
ON
OFF
T1
T2 T1
T3
Normal Wave of PANIC Switch
ON
OFF
T3
T3
Unmatched Recognition Code
ON
OFF
Wave is being received
No Diagnosis Output
T1: 0.13 sec.
T2: 0.25 sec.
T3: 0.5 sec.
OFF
B127179E02
Result:
Result
Proceed to
Unmatched recognition code is output
A
Normal waves (patterns of room light) for LOCK, UNLOCK and PANIC
switches are output
B
DL–86
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
Result
Proceed to
No diagnosis outputs are present
C
B
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
ASSEMBLY (MAIN BODY ECU)
C
Go to step 8
A
7
REGISTER RECOGNITION CODE
(a) Check that the system can switch to rewrite mode or add
mode and that a recognition code can be registered (see
page DL-142).
OK:
System can switch to rewrite mode or add mode
and recognition code can be registered.
DL
NG
Go to step 15
OK
END
8
CHECK DOOR CONTROL RECEIVER (RESPONSE)
(a) Temporarily replace the door control receiver with a new
or normally functioning one.
(b) Check that an unmatching recognition code is output
when the door lock control transmitter switch is held
down.
OK:
Unmatching recognition code is output.
NG
Go to step 13
OK
REPLACE DOOR CONTROL TRANSMITTER
9
CONFIRM INPUT METHOD OF SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
Result:
Result
Proceed to
Method for changing system self-diagnostic mode works
A
Method for changing system self-diagnostic mode does not work
B
B
Go to step 5
DL–87
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
A
10
INSPECT KEY SLOT
(a) Measure the resistance of the halfway switch.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
2-4
5
4
3
2
Condition
Specified Condition
No key is in key slot
10 kΩ or higher
Key is in key slot
Below 1 Ω
1
NG
KSW1
REPLACE KEY SLOT
COM
B127180E02
OK
11
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (CERTIFICATION ECU - DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK AND
KEY SLOT)
Wire Harness Side
S11
Driver Side Junction Block
Certification ECU
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
1E
2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12
13 14 15 16
17 18 19 20 2122 23 24
25 26 27 28
29 30 31 32
1
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40
Key Slot
KSW
KSW
KSW
K2
1 2 3 4 5
COM
KSW1
B127181E03
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Disconnect the S11 and B7 ECU connectors.
Disconnect the K2 slot connector.
Disconnect the 1E junction block connector.
Measure the resistance of wire harness side connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S11-4 (KSW) - 1E-23 (KSW)
K2-4 (KSW1) - 1E-26 (KSW)
Below 1 Ω
K2-2 (COM) - Body ground
NG
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
DL
DL–88
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
12
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (DOOR CONTROL RECEIVER - BATTERY AND BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the D4 receiver connector.
(b) Measure the voltage and resistance of the wire harness
side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
Tester Connection
D4
D4-5 (+5) - Body ground
1 2 3 4 5
GND
GND
Standard resistance
+5
Tester Connection
B127182E04
Specified Condition
D4-1 (GND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
D4-2 (GND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
DL
Specified Condition
10 to 14 V
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
13
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (DOOR CONTROL RECEIVER - CERTIFICATION ECU)
(a) Disconnect the D4 receiver connector.
(b) Disconnect the S11 ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Door Control Receiver
Tester Connection
D4-4 (DATA) - S11-10 (RDA)
D4
D4-3 (RSSI) - S11-11 (RSSI)
1 2 3 4 5
RSSI
D4-4 (DATA) - S11-10 (RDA) - Body
ground
D4-3 (RSSI) - S11-11 (RSSI) - Body
ground
DATA
NG
S11
Certification ECU
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40
RDA
RSSI
B127176E04
OK
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
10 kΩ or higher
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
14
DL–89
CHECK DOOR CONTROL RECEIVER (OUTPUT)
(a) Reconnect the D4 receiver connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the connector.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
5
4
3
2
Condition
1
D4-3 (RSSI) - Body
ground
Transmitter switch OFF
(power switch OFF and
all doors closed)
RSSI
D4-3 (RSSI) - Body
ground
Transmitter switch ON
(power switch OFF and
all doors closed)
Specified Condition
Below 1 V
Alternating between 6
to 7 V and below 1 V
B127180E04
OK
Go to step 16
NG
15
CHECK DOOR CONTROL TRANSMITTER (OPERATION)
(a) Temporarily replace the door control transmitter with a
new or normally functioning one.
(b) Check that the doors can be locked and unlocked by
using the transmitter LOCK/UNLOCK switch.
OK:
Doors can be locked and unlocked with
transmitter.
NG
REPLACE DOOR CONTROL RECEIVER
OK
END (DOOR CONTROL TRANSMITTER IS DEFECTIVE)
16
CHECK CERTIFICATION ECU (OPERATION)
(a) Temporarily replace the certification ECU with a new or
normally functioning one.
(b) Check that the door can be locked and unlocked by
using the transmitter LOCK/UNLOCK switch.
OK:
Doors can be locked and unlocked with
transmitter.
NG
OK
END (CERTIFICATION ECU IS DEFECTIVE)
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
ASSEMBLY (MAIN BODY ECU)
DL
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
DL–87
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK
CONTROL SYSTEM (w/o Smart
Key System)
PRECAUTION
NOTICE:
For initialization:
When disconnecting the cable from the negative (-)
battery terminal, initialize the following system after the
cable is reconnected.
System Name
Power Window Control System
See procedure
IN-32
For hybrid system activation:
When the warning light is illuminated or the battery has
been disconnected and reconnected, pressing the power
switch may not start the system on the first try. If so,
press the power switch again.
DL
DL–88
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
PARTS LOCATION
DOOR CONTROL RECEIVER
DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
- MAIN BODY ECU
- TURN SIGNAL FLASHER RELAY
FRONT DOOR COURTESY LIGHT SWITCH RH
FRONT DOOR LOCK RH
REAR DOOR COURTESY LIGHT
SWITCH RH
KEY SLOT
- HALFWAY SWITCH
DL
REAR DOOR LOCK RH
FRONT DOOR LOCK LH
FRONT DOOR COURTESY
LIGHT SWITCH LH
BACK DOOR LOCK OPENER SWITCH
REAR DOOR LOCK LH
REAR DOOR COURTESY LIGHT SWITCH LH
BACK DOOR LOCK
- BACK DOOR COURTESY SWITCH
B129148E02
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
DL–89
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
Key (Door Control Transmitter)
Front Door Lock (LH, RH)
Door Control Receiver
Rear Door Lock (LH, RH)
Key Slot
- Halfway Switch
Back Door Lock
Front Door Courtesy Light
Switch (LH, RH)
Rear Door Courtesy Light
Switch (LH, RH)
Main Body
ECU
Interior Relay
Flasher Relay
Horn Relay
Back Door Courtesy Light
Switch
Headlight Relay
Door Lock Position
Switches
Taillight Relay
B074726E02
DL
DL–90
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
2.
DL
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM
DESCRIPTION
(a) This system is locks and unlocks the vehicle's doors
remotely. The wireless door lock control system has
the following features:
• The door control receiver performs the code
identification process and the main body ECU
operates the door lock control. A serial data link
is provided for communication between the door
control receiver and main body ECU.
• A key-integrated type transmitter is used and it
contains the following 3 switches: the door lock
switch, door unlock switch and panic switch.
• An LED is mounted on the transmitter to show if
the battery is depleted.
FUNCTION OF MAIN COMPONENTS
Components
Functions
•
•
Door control transmitter
•
Contains LOCK, UNLOCK and PANIC switches
Transmits faint electric waves (recognition codes and function
codes) to door control receiver
Illuminates indicator light (LED) during transmission
Door control receiver
Receives faint electric waves (recognition codes and function codes)
and outputs them as code data to main body ECU
Key slot (halfway switch)
Detects if key slot has key or not
Front door courtesy light switch
Rear door courtesy light switch
Back door courtesy light switch
Turn on when door is open and turns off when door is closed. Outputs
door status (open or closed) to main body ECU
Door lock position switch
Transmits door lock positions of each door to main body ECU
3.
SYSTEM FUNCTION
(a) Door lock/unlock function:
With no key in the key slot (halfway switch is off)
and all door courtesy light switches off, pressing the
door control transmitter's LOCK/UNLOCK switch
causes transmitter to output faint electric waves
which are input to the door control receiver. The
door control receiver converts these waves into
code data in its internal high frequency circuit and
outputs the code data (recognition codes and
function codes) to the main body ECU. Upon
receiving a door lock/unlock request signal, the
main body ECU outputs a door lock/unlock control
signal to each door lock. Each door lock then locks/
unlocks its respective door and turns on/off its door
lock position switch according to the signal.
(b) Answer-back function:
The main body ECU receives the door unlock
detection switch's on/off signals and uses these
signals to confirm if door control operation has
completed. The main body ECU then outputs the
hazard warning lights's output control signals to
flash the hazard warning light as an answer-back.
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
DL–91
(c) Panic function:
When the door control transmitter's PANIC switch is
pressed, the door control receiver receives the code
data (recognition codes and function codes) from
the door control transmitter in the same way as
when the LOCK/UNLOCK switch is pressed. Upon
receiving a theft deterrent alarm control signal, the
main body ECU actuates a built-in relay to cause
the security horn to sound, as well as transmit
several kinds of warning signals (hazard warning
light control signal, vehicle horn warning control
signal, headlight warning signal and taillight warning
signal) in order to output a theft deterrent alarm.
(d) The wireless door lock control system has the
following functions.
Function
Outline
All door unlock function
Pressing LOCK switch locks all doors.
All door unlock function (for 2 step unlock operation)
Pressing UNLOCK switch once will unlock driver side door. Pressing
UNLOCK switch again within 3 seconds will unlock remaining doors.
Answer-back function
Hazard warning lights flash once when doors are locked, and flash
twice when doors are unlocked to inform that operation has been
completed
Panic function
Holding down PANIC switch sets off theft deterrent alarm, which
consists of sounding horn, and flashing headlights, taillights and
hazard warning lights
Automatic lock function
If no doors are opened within 30 seconds after they are unlocked by
wireless door lock remote control, all doors will lock again
automatically
Repeat function
If door is not locked in response to locking operation of transmitter,
main body ECU will output lock signal after 1 second
Illuminated entry function
With all doors locked, pressing UNLOCK switch causes room light to
illuminate simultaneously with unlocking again
Security function
Sends signal as rolling code
Transmitter recognition code registration function
Enables 3 modes for registering (writing and storing) transmitter
recognition codes in EEPROM, which is built into main body ECU
Self-diagnosis
If system has malfunction, main body ECU sets DTC in its memory
DL
DL–92
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
• Use these procedures to troubleshoot the wireless door
lock control system.
• *: Use the intelligent tester.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
INSPECT BATTERY VOLTAGE
Standard voltage:
11 to 14 V
If the voltage is below 11 V, recharge or replace the battery
before proceeding
DL
NEXT
3
INSPECT COMMUNICATION FUNCTION OF LARGE-SCALE MULTIPLEX
COMMUNICATION SYSTEM (BEAN)*
(a) Using the intelligent tester, check if the Multiplex
Communication System (MPX) is functioning normally
(see page MP-16).
Result:
Result
Proceed to
MPX DTC is not output
A
MPX DTC is output
B
B
Go to MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION
SYSTEM
A
4
CHECK FOR DTC*
(a) Check for DTCs and note any codes that are output.
(b) Delete the DTC.
(c) Recheck for DTCs. Try to prompt the DTC by simulating
the original activity that the DTC suggests.
Result:
Result
Proceed to
DTC does not reoccur
A
DTC reoccurs
B
B
Go to step 7
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
DL–93
A
5
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Result:
Result
Proceed to
Fault is not listed in problem symptoms
table
A
Fault is listed in problem symptoms
table
B
B
Go to step 7
A
6
OVERALL ANALYSIS AND TROUBLESHOOTING*
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
NEXT
7
ADJUST, REPAIR OR REPLACE
NEXT
8
NEXT
END
CONFIRMATION TEST
Operation check (see page DL-93)
DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST (see page DL-107)
Terminals of ECU (see page DL-104)
Inspection (see page DL-217)
DL
DL–94
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
OPERATION CHECK
1.
DL
2.
NOTES WHEN CHECKING
(a) Wireless door LOCK/UNLOCK function:
This function operates only when the following 4
conditions are met.
• No key is inserted into the key slot.
• All the doors are closed.
• The power door lock control system is
functioning normally.
HINT:
The UNLOCK function operates even when one of
the doors is open.
(b) Panic function:
This wireless control function operates only when
the following condition is met.
• The power switch must be OFF.
HINT:
The key can be inserted. However the power switch
must be OFF.
(c) The wireless transmitter operating range differs
depending on the situation.
• The operating range differs depending on the
user, the way the transmitter is held and the
location.
• In certain areas, the operating range will be
reduced due to the vehicle body shape and the
influence of the surrounding environment.
• Since the transmitter uses faint electric waves,
the operating range might be shortened if noise
or strong electric waves occur in the area where
the transmitter is used. Or, the transmitter may
not function.
• When the battery weakens, the operating range
is reduced or the transmitter may not function.
HINT:
If the transmitter has been left in a place that is
exposed to direct sunlight, such as on the
instrument panel, the battery may weaken or other
problem may occur.
WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL FUNCTIONS
HINT:
• The switches described below transmit signals and
are built into the door control transmitter.
• The operating range must be taken into account while
checks are being made.
(a) Make sure the vehicle is in a condition where the
wireless door lock control function can be operated
(see above).
(b) Check basic functions:
• Check that the transmitter's LED illuminates 3
times when each switch is pressed 3 times.
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
(g)
(h)
DL–95
HINT:
If the LED does not illuminate when the switch has
been pressed 3 times or more, the battery may be
depleted.
• Check that all doors (including the back door)
lock when the LOCK switch is pressed.
• Check that only the driver side door unlocks
when the UNLOCK switch is pressed once, and
that the remaining doors unlock when the
UNLOCK switch is pressed again within 3
seconds.
Check the chattering prevention function:
• Check that pressing a switch will result in the
switch's operation occurring only once; and when
the switch is held down, the operation is not
repeated continuously. Also, make sure that
when the switch is pressed at intervals of
approximately 1 second, the switch's operation
activates once for every press of the switch.
Check the automatic locking function:
• Check that if all of the doors are unlocked with
the UNLOCK switch and none of the doors are
opened or locked within approximately 30
seconds, the door automatically relocks.
• Check that if all of the doors are unlocked with
the UNLOCK switch and a door is opened or
locked within approximately 30 seconds, the
automatic locking function does not operate.
Check the switch operation fail-safe function:
• Check that the doors cannot be locked by a
transmitter switch while the key is in the key slot.
However, this does not apply when the system is
in recognition code registration mode.
Check the operation stop function when a door is
open or not completely closed:
• Check that if a door is open or not completely
closed, the doors cannot be locked by the LOCK
switch.
Check the repeat function:
• Check that if the LOCK switch is pressed while
the movement of the driver side door control
knob (in the unlocked state) is restricted, the
repeat function attempts to lock all of the doors
again 2 seconds later.
Check the answer-back function:
• When the LOCK switch is pressed, confirm the
simultaneous occurrence of all the hazard
warning lights flashing once, the buzzer sounding
once and all the doors locking.
• When the UNLOCK switch is pressed, confirm
the simultaneous occurrence of all the hazard
warning lights flashing twice and the driver side
door unlocking.
DL
DL–96
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
(i)
(j)
DL
• When UNLOCK switch is pressed again within 3
seconds, conform the simultaneous occurrence
of all the hazard warning lights flashing twice and
all the doors unlocking.
Check the illuminated entry function:
• When all the doors are locked, pressing the
UNLOCK switch causes the room light (when the
light switch is in the DOOR position) to illuminate
simultaneously with the unlock operation.
• Check that the room light turns off in
approximately 15 seconds if doors have not been
opened.
Check the panic function:
(1) Check that if PANIC switch is held down for 0.8
seconds or more, the theft deterrent alarm
function sounds the horn and flashes the
headlights and taillights for 60 seconds. And,
with the theft alarm function active, check if
pressing any switch on the transmitter causes
the horn to stop sounding and the headlights
and taillights to stop flashing.
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
DL–97
REGISTRATION
1.
2.
DESCRIPTION OF CODE REGISTRATION
HINT:
• Recognition code registration is necessary when
replacing the door control transmitter and/or the door
control receiver.
• Add mode is used to register new recognition codes
while retaining codes already registered. This mode is
used when a new transmitter is added. If the number
of registered codes exceeds 4, the previously
registered codes will be erased in order, starting from
the first registered code.
• Rewrite mode is used to erased all the previously
registered recognition codes in order to register new
recognition codes. This mode is used when the
transmitter or the door control receiver is exchanged
for a new one.
• Confirmation mode is used to confirm how many
recognition codes have already been registered
before registering any additional recognition codes.
• Prohibition mode is used to erase all the registered
codes and disables the wireless door lock function.
This mode is used when the transmitter is lost.
• All of the following registration procedures must be
performed in order and in a continuous sequence.
REGISTER RECOGNITION CODE (USING
INTELLIGENT TESTER)
HINT:
For detailed procedures, please refer to the prompts on
the tester screen. The number of currently registered
codes can be checked out on the first screen of the
WIRELESS REGIST.
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Select the menu on the intelligent tester.
HINT:
After the following operations, proceed to the
succeeding operations according to the prompts on
the tester screen.
(1) Select "PRIUS" from the menu.
(2) Select "W/O SMART KEY".
(3) Select "BODY".
(4) Select "WIRELESS REGIST".
(c) Press both LOCK and UNLOCK switches between
1 to 1.5 seconds.
(d) Press either switch for more than 1 second within 3
seconds.
DL
DL–98
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
(e) Check the response to the registration completion.
Response to registration completion:
Body ECU automatically performs power door LOCK-UNLOCK operation to show whether registration has
been completed correctly or not.
LOCK-UNLOCK Occurs Once
LOCK-UNLOCK Occurs Twice
Registration of recognition code has
been completed.
Registration of recognition code has
failed.
T1 T1
T1
DL
LOCK
LOCK
UNLOCK
UNLOCK
T1: Approx. 1 second
B111915E07
(f)
3.
HINT:
• If the LOCK-UNLOCK operation is occurs twice,
the registration of recognition code has failed.
Perform the registration procedures again from
beginning.
• If registering another transmitter, repeat the
procedures after the tester operation. All 4
recognition codes can be registered
consecutively.
Perform the either of following to complete the
registration of recognition codes:
• Use the intelligent tester to send completion
command.
• Disconnect the intelligent tester.
REGISTER RECOGNITION CODE (USING SWITCH
OPERATION)
(a) The following the conditions should be met.
• No key in the key slot.
• The driver side door is opened (the other doors
are closed).
• The driver side door is unlocked.
(b) Insert and remove the key into / from the key slot
twice (Insert → Remove → Insert → Remove) within
5 seconds.
HINT:
The procedure should end with the key removed.
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
DL–99
(c) Perform the following operations within 40 seconds.
(1) Close and open the driver side door twice
(Close → Open → Close → Open).
HINT:
The procedure should end with the door
opened.
(2) Insert and remove the key into / from the key
slot twice (Insert → Remove → Insert →
Remove).
HINT:
The procedure should end with the key
removed.
(3) Close and open the driver side door twice
(Close → Open → Close → Open).
HINT:
The procedure should end with the door
opened.
(4) Insert and remove the key into / from the key
slot twice (Insert → Remove → Insert →
Remove).
HINT:
The procedure should end with the key
removed.
(5) Insert the key into the key slot and close the all
doors.
DL
DL–100
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
(d) Perform the following operations within 40 seconds.
(1) Turn the power switch from ON (IG) to OFF at
approximately 1 second intervals, operate the
power switch according to the number of times
shown below.
Number of ON (IG) - OFF operations of power switch:
Add Mode
ON (IG) - OFF operation: Once
Rewrite Mode
ON (IG) - OFF operation: Twice
T1
T1 T1
ON (IG)
ON (IG)
OFF
OFF
DL
Confirmation Mode ON (IG) - OFF operation: 3 times
Prohibition Mode
T1 T1
ON (IG) - OFF operation: 5 times
T1 T1
ON (IG)
ON (IG)
OFF
OFF
T1: Approx. 1 second
B111914E08
HINT:
If the number of power switch ON (IG) - OFF
operations is 0, 4, 6 or more, there will be no
response (the power door lock and unlock
operation) to show which mode has been
selected.
(2) Remove the key from the key slot.
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
DL–101
(e) Check the response of the selected mode within 5
seconds.
Response to selected mode (power door lock operation):
Body ECU automatically performs power door LOCK-UNLOCK operations to indicate which mode has been
selected.
LOCK-UNLOCK operation: Once
Add Mode
Rewrite Mode
LOCK-UNLOCK operation: Twice
T1 T1
T1
LOCK
LOCK
UNLOCK
UNLOCK
DL
Confirmation Mode LOCK-UNLOCK operation: The number of registered codes (1 to 5 times)
1st Time
T2
2nd Time
T2
LOCK
UNLOCK
T1: Approx. 1 second
T2: Approx. 2 seconds
Prohibition Mode
LOCK-UNLOCK operation: 5 times
T1 T1
LOCK
UNLOCK
B111913E05
DL–102
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
NOTICE:
After the system has been set to the prohibition
mode, enter the confirmation mode and check
that the number of registered keys is 0.
HINT:
• In the confirmation mode, LOCK-UNLOCK
operation will occur once for each recognition
code that has been registered. For example, if 2
recognition codes have been registered, LOCKUNLOCK operation will occur twice.
• In the confirmation mode, if no recognition codes
have been registered, LOCK-UNLOCK operation
will occur 5 times.
• If confirmation mode or prohibition mode is
selected, the operation ends after the response
to the selected mode completes.
(f) Within 40 seconds of completing the confirmation
mode operation, press the LOCK and UNLOCK
switches on the transmitter simultaneously.
(g) After completing the step above, press a single
switch (LOCK or UNLOCK) within 5 seconds.
(h) After completing the step above, check the
response to the registration completion within 3
seconds.
DL
Response to registration completion:
Body ECU automatically performs power door LOCK-UNLOCK operation to show whether registration has
been completed correctly or not.
LOCK-UNLOCK Occurs Once
LOCK-UNLOCK Occurs Twice
Registration of recognition code has
been completed.
Registration of recognition code has
failed.
T1 T1
T1
LOCK
LOCK
UNLOCK
UNLOCK
T1: Approx. 1 second
B111915E08
HINT:
• If the LOCK-UNLOCK operation occurs twice,
the registration of recognition code has failed.
Perform registration procedures again from the
beginning.
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
(i)
DL–103
• If registering another transmitter, repeat the
procedures after the response to the selected
mode confirmation. All 4 recognition codes can
be registered consecutively.
Perform either of the following to complete the
registration of recognition codes:
• Open the door.
• Insert the key into the key slot.
DL
DL–104
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
CUSTOMIZE PARAMETERS
1.
CUSTOMIZING FUNCTION WITH INTELLIGENT
TESTER (REFERENCE)
HINT:
The following items can be customized.
NOTICE:
• When the customer requests a change in a function,
first make sure that the functions can be customized.
• Be sure to record the current settings before
customizing.
• When troubleshooting a function, first make sure that
the function is set to the default setting.
Wireless door lock control system:
Display (Items)
Contents
Setting
ON
If door is not completely closed
and transmitter LOCK switch is
pressed, this function sounds
buzzer for 10 seconds
ON / OFF
ON
Function that operates theft
deterrent alarm when transmitter
PANIC switch is held 0.8
seconds.
ON / OFF
UNLOCK/2OPER (Wireless
unlock operated twice)
ON
Function that unlocks driver side
door when UNLOCK switch on
transmitter is pressed once, and
unlocks all doors when pressed
twice. If set to OFF, pressing
UNLOCK switch once unlocks all
doors.
ON / OFF
AUTO LOCK DELAY (Auto lock
time)
30s
This function controls amount of
time from unlocking doors to
automatic re-locking function
30s / 60s
ON
When LOCK switch on
transmitter is pressed, this
function illuminates all hazard
warning lights once. When
UNLOCK switch is pressed, all
hazard warning lights illuminate
twice
ON / OFF
OPEN DOOR WARN (Door ajar
warning function
DL
Default
ALARM FUNCTION (Panic
function)
HAZARD ANS BACK (Hazard
answer-back for wireless door
lock operation)
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
DL–105
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
• Use the table below to help determine the cause of the
problem symptom. The potential causes of the symptoms
are listed in order of probability in the "Suspected area"
column of the table. Check each symptom by checking the
suspected areas in the order they are listed. Replace parts
as necessary.
• Inspect the fuses and relays related to this system before
inspecting the suspected areas below.
Wireless door lock control system:
Symptom
Only wireless control function is inoperative
No answer-back
Suspected area
See page
1. Transmitter battery
DL-111
2. Door control transmitter
DL-111
3. Door control receiver
DL-111
4. Key slot
DL-111
5. Wire harness
DL-111
6. Driver side junction block (main body ECU)
DL-111
7. Lighting system
DL-111
1. Lighting system
DL-119
2. Wire harness
DL-119
3. Driver side junction block (main body ECU)
DL-119
DL
DL–106
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
CHECK DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK (MAIN
BODY ECU)
Vehicle Rear Side
1D
Vehicle Front Side
B7
1A
1E
1B
DL
1J
1L
1D
1A
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
8
9
10
11
23
24
25
26
9
10
11
12
27
28
29
30
12
13
14
15
27
28
29
30
13
14
15
16
17
18
31
32
33
34
35
36
1E
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
9
10
11
12
25
26
27
28
13
14
15
16
29
30
31
32
B7
6
5
4
3
2
1
17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7
26 25 24 23
22 21 20 19 18
1L
10 1112131415161718
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
1B
1
1J
3 2
1
8 7 6 5 4
B127174E01
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
DL–107
(a) Disconnect the 1A, 1B, 1D, 1E and 1J junction block
connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance and voltage of the wire
harness side connectors.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
GND (1E-17) - Body
ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground
SIG (1B-1) - Body ground
W - Body ground
Ignition power supply
ACC (1J-5) - Body ground
G - Body ground
Ignition power supply
ECUB (1A-30) - Body
ground
R - Body ground
+B (ECUB) power supply
KSW (1E-23) - Body
ground
Y - Body ground
KSW (1E-26) - Body
ground
Key unlock warning switch
input
DCTY (1D-21) - Body
ground
V - Body ground
Driver side door courtesy
switch input
PCTY (1D-24) - Body
ground
BR - Body ground
Passenger side door
courtesy switch input
BCTY (1D-7) - Body
ground
R- Body ground
Back door courtesy switch
input
Condition
Specified Condition
Always
Below 1 Ω
Power switch OFF
Below 1 V
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
Power switch OFF
Below 1 V
Power switch ON (ACC)
10 to 14 V
Always
10 to 14 V
No key in key slot
10 kΩ or higher
Key inserted
Below 1 Ω
No key in key slot
10 kΩ or higher
Key inserted
Below 1 Ω
Driver side door closed
10 kΩ or higher
Driver side door open
Below 1 Ω
Passenger side door
closed
10 kΩ or higher
Passenger side door open
Below 1 Ω
Back door closed
10 kΩ or higher
Back door open
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
(c) Reconnect the 1A, 1B, 1D, 1E and 1J junction block
connectors.
(d) Measure the voltage of the connectors.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
HAZ (1L-17) - Body
ground
RDA (B7-23) - Body
ground
Wiring Color
Y - Body ground
L- Body ground
Terminal Description
Hazard warning light drive
Door control receiver input
Condition
Specified Condition
Answer-back OFF
Below 1 V
Answer-back ON
Pulse generation
Transmitter switch OFF
(power switch OFF and all
door closed)
Below 1 V
Transmitter switch ON
(power switch OFF and all
door closed)
Pulse generation
If the result is not as specified, the junction block
(ECU) have a malfunction.
DL
DL–108
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
1.
DESCRIPTION
(a) Wireless door lock control system data and the
Diagnosis Trouble Codes (DTCs) can be read
through the Data Link Connector 3 (DLC3). When
the system seems to be malfunctioning, use the
intelligent tester to check for malfunctions and
perform repairs.
2.
CHECK DLC3
(a) The vehicle uses the ISO 15765-4 communication
protocol. The terminal arrangement of the DLC3
complies with SAE J1962 and matches the ISO
15765-4 format.
CG SG CANH SIL
CANL
DL
BAT
H100769E16
Symbols (Terminal No.)
SIL (7) - SG (5)
Terminal Description
Bus "+" line
CG (4) - Body ground
Chassis ground
SG (5) - Body ground
Signal ground
BAT (16) - Body ground
Battery positive
Condition
During transmission
Always
Below 1 Ω
11 to 14 V
54 to 69 Ω
CANH (6) - CANL (14)
CANH (6) - Battery positive
HIGH-level CAN bus line
CANH (6) - CG (4)
1 kΩ or higher
Power switch OFF
CANL (14) - Battery positive
CANL (14) - CG (4)
Specified Condition
Pulse generation
LOW-level CAN bus line
1 kΩ or higher
1 MΩ or higher
1 MΩ or higher
If the result is not as specified, the DLC3 may have
a malfunction. Repair or replace the harness and
connector.
HINT:
Connect the cable of the intelligent tester (with CAN
VIM) to the DLC3, turn the power switch ON (IG)
and attempt to use the tester. If the screen displays
the message UNABLE TO CONNECT TO
VEHICLE, there is a problem either with the vehicle
or with the tester.
• If communication is normal when the tester is
connected to another vehicle, inspect the DLC3
of the original vehicle.
• If communication is still not possible when the
tester is connected to another vehicle, the
problem is probably in the tester itself. Consult
the Service Department listed in the tester's
instruction manual.
Intelligent Tester
DLC3
CAN VIM
B126098E01
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
DL–109
DTC CHECK / CLEAR
Intelligent Tester
1.
2.
DLC3
CAN VIM
CHECK DTC
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the CAN VIM. Then
connect the CAN VIM to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Read the DTCs by following the directions on the
tester screen.
CLEAR DTC
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Erase the DTCs by following the directions on the
tester screen.
B126098E01
DL
DL–110
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST
1.
READ DATA LIST
HINT:
Using the intelligent tester's DATA LIST allows switch,
actuator and other item values to be read without
removing any parts. Reading the DATA LIST early in
troubleshooting is one way to save time.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Read the DATA LIST.
Main body ECU:
Item
DL
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
D DOR CTY SW
Driver side door courtesy switch
signal / ON or OFF
ON: Driver side door is open
OFF: Driver side door is closed
-
P DOR CTY SW
Passenger side door courtesy
switch signal / ON or OFF
ON: Passenger side door is open
OFF: Passenger side door is
closed
-
Rr DOR CTY SW
Rear door courtesy switch signal /
ON or OFF
ON: Either right or left door is
open
OFF: Both right and left doors are
closed
-
D LOCK POS SW
Driver side door lock position
switch signal / ON or OFF
ON: Driver side door lock is in
unlock position
OFF: Driver side door lock is in
lock position
-
P LOCK POS SW
Passenger side door lock position
switch signal / ON or OFF
ON: Passenger side door lock is
in unlock position
OFF: Passenger side door lock is
in lock position
-
Rr LOCK POS SW
Rear door lock position switch
signal / ON or OFF
ON: Rear door lock is in unlock
position
OFF: Rear door lock is in lock
position
-
REGIST ID CODE
Number of registered ID / Min. 0,
Max. 4
Number of registered ID codes
-
Transponder key ECU:
Item
KEY UNLK WRN SW
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Halfway switch signal / ON or
OFF
2.
Normal Condition
ON: Key is in key slot.
OFF: No key is in key slot.
Diagnostic Note
-
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST
HINT:
Performing the intelligent tester's ACTIVE TEST allows
relay, VSV, actuator, and other items to be operated
without removing any parts. Performing the ACTIVE
TEST early in troubleshooting is one way to save time.
The DATA LIST can be displayed during the ACTIVE
TEST.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
DL–111
(c) Perform the ACTIVE TEST according to the display
on the tester.
Main body ECU:
Item
HAZARD
Tester Details
Diagnostic Note
Turns turn signal flasher relay ON / OFF
-
TRUNK/BDOR OPEN
Operate back door motor ON / OFF
-
DOOR LOCK
Operate door lock motor for all doors OFF /
LOCK / UNLOCK
All doors are closed
DL
DL–112
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
Wireless door lock control system:
DTC No.
B1242
DL
Detection Item
Trouble Area
See page
Wireless Door Lock Tuner Circuit
Malfunction
- Door control receiver
- Wire harness
- Driver side junction block (main
body ECU)
DL-109
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
DTC
B1242
DL–113
Wireless Door Lock Tuner Circuit Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
This DTC is detected when a RDA signal is not input to the door control receiver within 1 second after the
main body ECU outputs PRG signal.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Within 1 second after PRG signal is output
from body ECU during self-diagnostic mode,
corresponding RDA signal is not output.
B1242
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Door control receiver
Wire harness
Driver side junction block (main body
ECU)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Door Control Receiver
GND
Main Body ECU
PRG
PRG
RDA
RDA
+B
from Battery
GND
B135641E01
DL
DL–114
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (DOOR CONTROL RECEIVER - MAIN BODY ECU AND BODY
GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the D4 receiver connector.
(b) Disconnect the B7 ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance and voltage of the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Door Control Receiver
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D4-2 (RDA) - B7-23 (RDA)
D4-3 (PRG) - B7-24 (PRG)
D4
1 2 3 4 5
GND
DL
D4-2 (RDA) or B7-23 (RDA) - Body
ground
+B
RDA
D4-3 (PRG) or B7-24 (PRG) - Body
ground
PRG
NG
Body ECU
B7
1
2
3
4
5
Below 1 Ω
D4-1 (GND) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
6
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
18 19 20 21
22 23 24 25 26
RDA
PRG
B135642E01
OK
2
CHECK DOOR CONTROL RECEIVER (OPERATION)
(a) Temporarily replace the door control receiver with a new
or normally functioning one.
(b) Check that no DTC is output.
OK:
DTC is not output.
NG
OK
END (DOOR CONTROL RECEIVER IS DEFECTIVE)
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
ASSEMBLY (MAIN BODY ECU)
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
DL–115
Only Wireless Control Function is Inoperative
DESCRIPTION
The door control receiver receives signals from the transmitter and sends these signals to the main body
ECU. The main body ECU then controls all doors by sending lock/unlock signals to each door lock.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Door Control Receiver
Main Body ECU
PRG
PRG
RDA
RDA
+B
DL
from Battery
ECU-IG
SIG
to IG Relay
ACC
to ACC Relay
ACC
Key Slot
COM
KSW1
KSW
GND
B135647E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL FUNCTION
(a) Check the wireless door lock control functions (see page
DL-93).
DL–116
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
OK:
Each function of wireless door lock control system
operates normally using transmitter switches.
OK
NORMAL
NG
2
CHECK THAT TRANSMITTER LED LIGHT UP
(a) Check that the transmitter's LED illuminates 3 times
when the switch is pressed 3 times.
OK:
Transmitter's LED illuminates 3 times when switch
is pressed 3 times.
NG
DL
Go to step 4
OK
3
CHECK WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL FUNCTION (STANDARD OPERATION)
(a) Check standard UNLOCK/LOCK switch operation.
NOTICE:
Standardized test procedures:
Press the transmitter switch for 1 second, directing
the transmitter to the driver side door outside handle
from a distance of 1 m (3.28 ft.). The transmitter
should be pointed directly at the handle, i.e. a 90°
angle to vehicle body.
OK:
Doors can be locked and unlocked with
transmitter.
NG
Go to step 5
OK
REPLACE DOOR CONTROL TRANSMITTER
4
CHECK TRANSMITTER BATTERY (OPERATION)
(a) Temporarily replace the transmitter battery with a new or
normally functioning one.
(b) Check that the doors can be locked and unlocked by
using the transmitter LOCK/UNLOCK switch.
OK:
Doors can be locked and unlocked with transmitter
switch.
NG
REPLACE DOOR CONTROL TRANSMITTER
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
DL–117
OK
END (TRANSMITTER BATTERY IS DEFECTIVE)
5
SWITCH TO SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
Room Light
a: 0.13 sec.
b: 0.15 sec.
ON
OFF
a
b
B052341E09
(a) Switch to self diagnostic mode using the intelligent
tester.
(1) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(2) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and push the
intelligent tester main switch ON.
HINT:
Please refer to the intelligent tester operator's
manual for further details.
(b) Switch to self diagnostic mode by operating the key.
(1) Put the vehicle under the vehicle's initial condition
(see page DL-93), insert the key into the key slot
and remove it.
(2) Within 5 seconds of removing the key (above step),
insert the key into the key slot. Then turn the power
switch ON (IG) and OFF.
(3) Within 30 seconds of switching the power switch
OFF (step above), perform the following 9 times: .
Turn the power switch ON (IG) and OFF*
NOTICE:
If the change to self diagnostic mode has failed,
the system will return to normal mode.
HINT:
• Turning the power switch ON (IG) after step * has
been completed will end self-diagnostic mode.
• Do not lock or unlock doors during the selfdiagnostic mode.
(c) Check that the system has switched to self diagnostic
mode by checking the flashes of the room light (dome
light or key slot light). Compare the flash patterns of the
room light to the timing chart on the illustration.
OK:
Flash pattern of room light should be the same as
that shown in timing chart on illustration.
NG
Go to step 9
OK
6
CHECK BY SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
(a) Inspect the diagnosis outputs when the door control
transmitter switch is held down. The diagnosis outputs
can be checked by flash patterns of the room light.
DL
DL–118
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
Flash Pattern of Room Light
Normal Wave of LOCK Switch
ON
OFF
T1
T3
Normal Wave of UNLOCK Switch
DL
ON
OFF
T1
T2 T1
T3
Normal Wave of PANIC Switch
ON
OFF
T3
T3
Unmatched Recognition Code
ON
OFF
Wave is being received
No Diagnosis Output
T1: 0.13 sec.
T2: 0.25 sec.
T3: 0.5 sec.
OFF
B127179E02
Result:
Result
Proceed to
Unmatched recognition code is output
A
Normal waves (patterns of room light) for LOCK, UNLOCK and PANIC
switches are output
B
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
Result
DL–119
Proceed to
No diagnosis outputs are present
C
B
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
ASSEMBLY (MAIN BODY ECU)
C
Go to step 8
A
7
REGISTER RECOGNITION CODE
(a) Check that the system can switch to rewrite mode or add
mode and recognition code can be registered.
OK:
System can switch to rewrite mode or add mode
and recognition code can be registered.
NG
Go to step 15
OK
END
8
CHECK DOOR CONTROL RECEIVER (RESPONSE)
(a) Temporarily replace the door control receiver with a new
or normally functioning one.
(b) Check that an unmatching recognition code is output
when the door lock control transmitter switch is held
down.
OK:
Unmatching recognition code is output.
NG
Go to step 12
OK
REPLACE DOOR CONTROL TRANSMITTER
9
CONFIRM INPUT METHOD OF SELF-DIAGNOSTIC MODE
Result:
Result
Proceed to
Method for changing system self diagnostic mode works
A
Method for changing system self diagnostic mode does not work
B
B
Go to step 5
DL
DL–120
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
A
10
INSPECT KEY SLOT
(a) Measure the resistance of the halfway switch.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
2-4
5
4
3
2
Condition
Specified Condition
No key is in key slot
10 kΩ or higher
Key is in key slot
Below 1 Ω
1
NG
KSW1
REPLACE KEY SLOT
COM
B127180E02
OK
DL
11
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (KEY SLOT - DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK AND BODY
GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the K2 slot connector.
(b) Disconnect the 1E junction block connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Key Slot
Tester Connection
K2-4 (KSW1) - 1E-26 (KSW)
K2-2 (COM) - Body ground
K2
1 2 3 4 5
COM
NG
KSW1
Driver Side Junction Block
1E
2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12
13 14 15 16
17 18 19 20 2122 23 24
25 26 27 28
29 30 31 32
1
KSW
B135648E01
OK
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
12
DL–121
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (DOOR CONTROL RECEIVER - BATTERY AND BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the D4 receiver connector.
(b) Measure the resistance and voltage of the wire harness
side connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Tester Connection
D4
D4-1 (GND) - Body ground
1 2 3 4 5
GND
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
Standard voltage
+B
Tester Connection
B127182E06
D4-5 (+B) - Body ground
NG
Specified Condition
10 to 14 V
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
DL
OK
13
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (DOOR CONTROL RECEIVER - MAIN BODY ECU)
(a) Disconnect the D4 receiver connector.
(b) Disconnect the B7 ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Door Control Receiver
Tester Connection
D4-2 (RDA) - B7-23 (RDA)
D4-3 (PRG) - B7-24 (PRG)
D4
1 2 3 4 5
RDA
D4-2 (RDA) or B7-23 (RDA) - Body
ground
D4-3 (PRG) or B7-24 (PRG) - Body
ground
PRG
NG
Main Body ECU
B7
1
2
3
4
5
6
7 8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
18 19 20 21
22 23 24 25 26
RDA
PRG
B135642E02
OK
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
10 kΩ or higher
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
DL–122
14
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
CHECK DOOR CONTROL RECEIVER (OUTPUT)
(a) Reconnect the D4 receiver connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the connector.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
5
4
3
2
1
D4-2 (RDA) - Body
ground
RDA
Condition
Specified Condition
Transmitter switch OFF
(power switch OFF and
all doors closed)
Below 1 V
Transmitter switch ON
(power switch OFF and
all doors closed)
Alternating between 6
to 7 V and below 1 V
B127180E03
OK
DL
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
ASSEMBLY (MAIN BODY ECU)
NG
15
CHECK DOOR CONTROL TRANSMITTER (OPERATION)
(a) Temporarily replace the door control receiver with a new
or normally functioning one.
(b) Check that the doors can be locked and unlocked by
using the transmitter LOCK/UNLOCK switch.
OK:
Doors can be locked and unlocked with
transmitter.
NG
REPLACE DOOR CONTROL RECEIVER
OK
END (DOOR CONTROL TRANSMITTER IS DEFECTIVE)
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
DL–123
No Answer-Back
DESCRIPTION
In some cases, wireless door lock control functions are normal but hazard warning light answer-back is
not. In such case, the multiplex network body ECU's hazard warning light signal outputs may be
malfunctioning.
NOTICE:
Troubleshooting should be started after confirming that the answer-back function has been
switched ON.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL FUNCTION
(a) Check the wireless door lock control functions by
operating the transmitter switch.
Result:
Result
DL
Proceed to
Wireless door lock control functions are normal but hazard warning
light answer-back does not occur
A
Doors cannot be locked and unlocked with transmitter
B
B
GO TO PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
A
2
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (TURN SIGNAL FLASHER RELAY)
(a) Select ACTIVE TEST, use the intelligent tester to
generate a control command, and then check that the
hazard waning light flash.
Main body ECU:
Item
HAZARD
Test Detail
Diagnostic Note
Turn signal flasher relay ON / OFF
-
OK:
Turn signal flasher relay turns ON / OFF.
OK
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
ASSEMBLY (MAIN BODY ECU)
NG
3
CHECK HAZARD WARNING LIGHT
(a) Check that the hazard warning lights flash continuously
when the hazard warning signal switch is pressed.
OK:
Hazard warning lights flash continuously.
NG
GO TO LIGHTING SYSTEM
DL–124
DOOR LOCK – WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
OK
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK ASSEMBLY (MAIN BODY ECU)
DL
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
DL–121
SMART KEY SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
1.
NOTICE FOR INITIALIZATION
When disconnecting the cable from the negative (-)
battery terminal, initialize the following system(s) after
the cable is reconnected.
System Name
See procedure
Power Window Control System
IN-32
2.
3.
NOTICE FOR HYBRID SYSTEM ACTIVATION
When the warning light is illuminated or the battery has
been disconnected and reconnected, pressing the power
switch may not start the system on the first try. If so,
press the power switch again.
SMART KEY SYSTEM OPERATION PRECAUTIONS
(a) General entry functions:
(1) Functions and operating ranges:
The functions will not operate if the key is not
within the detection areas described below.
Furthermore, the functions may not operate or
their operating range may decrease if the battery
is depleted or strong radio waves or noise are
present. There are also areas in which the
functions may not operate properly due to the
shape of the vehicle body.
• Entry lock and entry unlock:
Applicable within approximately 0.7 to 1.0 m
(2.3 to 3.3 ft.) radius of each front outside
door handle. However, this function may not
operate if the key is near the windows or
outside door handles.
• Entry ignition:
Applicable within vehicle interior. This
function may not operate if the key is placed
on the instrument panel, on the rear package
tray, in the glove box, or on the floor. If the
key is placed outside of the vehicle near a
window, this function may not operate.
• Entry back door unlock:
Applicable within approximately 0.7 to 1.0 m
(2.3 to 3.3 ft.) radius of the back door opening
switch. However, this function may not
operate if the key is placed near the center of
the rear bumper.
DL
DL–122
DL
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
(2) The smart key system uses very faint radio
waves:
The entry functions and wireless door lock
control functions may not operate properly
(unable to operate the entry lock, unlock, ignition
and back door unlock functions, or a false alarm
is issued) in the situations described below. If so,
use the mechanical key to lock or unlock the
driver's door and insert the key into the key slot
to start the engine.
• A facility that generates strong radio waves is
nearby, such as a TV tower, electronic power
plant or broadcasting station.
• The user is carrying a wireless
communication device, such as a wireless
transmitter or portable telephone, along with
the key.
• The key is covered with a metal object or is
placed near a metal object.
• A radio wave type wireless door lock control
is being used in the vicinity.
• The key is near electrical appliances.
(b) Smart key system inoperative conditions:
The entry function will not operate under the
conditions listed below.
• The key cancel switch provided below the
driver's side instrument panel is turned ON.
• The key is inserted into the key slot.
• The key battery is depleted (the indicator light
does not flash when the switches on the key are
pressed).
DL–123
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
KEY WARNING LIGHT
COMBINATION METER
- METER ECU
KEY SLOT
DL
CERTIFICATION ECU
KEY CANCEL SWITCH
DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
- MAIN BODY ECU
B119813E03
DL–124
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
REAR DOOR COURTESY SWITCH RH
ELECTRICAL KEY ANTENNA RH
DOOR ELECTRICAL KEY
OSCILLATOR RH
FRONT DOOR COURTESY
SWITCH RH
DOOR CONTROL RECEIVER
ELECTRICAL KEY
ANTENNA LH
DL
DOOR ELECTRICAL KEY
OSCILLATOR LH
FRONT DOOR COURTESY
SWITCH LH
BACK DOOR OPENER SWITCH
INDOOR ELECTRICAL KEY
OSCILLATOR
REAR DOOR COURTESY SWITCH LH
LUGGAGE ELECTRICAL KEY OSCILLATOR
(OUTER)
LUGGAGE ELECTRICAL KEY OSCILLATOR (INNER)
ELECTRICAL KEY ANTENNA
(LUGGAGE)
B119814E02
DL–125
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
1.
OVERVIEW OF PARTS LAYOUT
Touch Sensor
Door Control Receiver
Door Electrical Key
Oscillator
Indoor Electrical Key
Oscillator
Key
Lock Switch
Luggage Electrical Key
Oscillator
Certification
ECU
Touch Switch
DL
Key Cancel Switch
Door Electrical Key
Oscillator
Back Door Opener
Switch
Lock Switch
Serial Communication
Main Body ECU
Luggage Electrical Key
Oscillator (Outer)
BEAN
Lock Switch
ECM
Hybrid Vehicle Control
ECU
CAN
Transponder Key
ECU
CAN
Gateway ECU
Transmission Control
ECU
Serial
Communication
ID Code Check
Power Source Control
ECU
Meter ECU
BEAN
B119815E03
DL–126
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
Hybrid Vehicle
Control ECU
Power Source
Control ECU
Power Switch
BEAN
DL
Outside Door Handle
- Touch Sensor
- Antenna
- Lock Switch
Main Body ECU
Certification
ECU
Transponder
Key ECU
Outside Door Handle
- Touch Sensor
- Antenna
- Lock Switch
Transponder
Key Amplifier
Door Electrical
Key Oscillator
Door Electrical
Key Oscillator
Indoor
Electrical
Key
Oscillator
Door
Control
Receiver
Luggage
Electrical Key
Oscillator
(Inner)
Luggage
Electrical Key
Oscillator
(Outer)
Key
Back Door Opener Switch
Lock Switch
B119816E02
Sender
Receiver
Signal
Line
Hybrid Vehicle Control ECU
Certification ECU
Shift position signal
BEAN
DL–127
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
Sender
Receiver
Signal
Line
Main Body ECU
Certification ECU
•
Driver door key-linked lock/
unlock signal (entry lock/
unlock control)
DTC erasure signal
Door lock position signal (D,
P, rear doors) (entry lock/
unlock control)
Electric back door status
signal (entry back door
control)
Courtesy switch signal (D, P,
rear doors) (entry lock/unlock,
warning control)
Vehicle specification signal
(entry control change)
IG switch signal (entire entry
control)
ACC switch signal (entry
warning control)
Halfway switch signal (entry
ignition control)
Back door switch signal
(entry back door control)
All door courtesy switch
signals (entry lock/unlock,
warning control)
BEAN
Entry control ON signal (entry
ignition control)
Steering lock release
activation signal (entry
ignition control)
BEAN
Immobiliser ID verification
request signal (entry ignition
control)
Key slot status (w/ or w/o key)
signal (entry ignition control)
Key code verification signal
(wireless control)
BEAN
Entry control ON signal (entry
ignition control)
Steering lock release
activation signal (entry
ignition control)
BEAN
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Transponder Key ECU
Certification ECU
•
•
Power Source Control ECU
Certification ECU
•
•
•
Certification ECU
Transponder Key ECU
•
•
DL
DL–128
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
DL
2.
SMART KEY SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
• In addition to the mechanical key function and the
wireless door lock control function, this system
provides the key with a bi-directional communication
function. This function enables the certification ECU
to recognize the presence of the key within several
detection areas. The system can lock or unlock the
doors, or start the hybrid system without key
operation as long as the key is in the user's
possession.
• This system consists of a certification ECU, power
source control ECU, transponder key ECU, multiplex
network body ECU, key, 5 oscillators, 5 antennas, 2
touch sensors, 3 trigger switches and a door control
receiver. The certification ECU controls the system.
• The smart key system (for door lock) operates in
conjunction with the smart key system (for starting),
the immobiliser system and the wireless door lock
control system.
FUNCTION OF MAIN COMPONENTS
Components
Function
Key
Receives signals from oscillators and returns ID code to door control
receiver
Door Electrical Key Oscillator (driver and front passenger doors)
Intermittently transmits key detection signals within detection area
around each door upon receiving transmission request signal from
certification ECU
Indoor Electrical Key Oscillator
Transmits key detection signals within detection area in vehicle interior
upon receiving transmission request signal from certification ECU
Luggage Compartment Electrical Key Oscillator (inner)
Transmits key detection signals within detection area in luggage room
upon receiving transmission request signal from certification ECU
Luggage Compartment Electrical Key Oscillator (outer)
Transmits key detection signals within detection area around luggage
compartment door upon receiving transmission request signal from
certification ECU
Electrical Key Antenna (luggage)
Transmits luggage electrical key oscillator signal
Outside Door Handle (driver and front passenger doors) (touch
sensor)
Transmits door unlock request signal to certification ECU when inside
of outside door handle is touched
Outside Door Handle (driver and front passenger doors) (antenna)
Transmits door electrical key oscillator signal
Outside Door Handle (driver and front passenger doors) (lock switch)
Transmits door unlock request signal to certification ECU
Back Door Opening Switch
Transmits back door open request signal to certification ECU via main
body ECU
Door Control Receiver
Receives ID code from key and transmits it to certification ECU
Power Switch
Changes vehicle's power modes between 4 stages (OFF, ON (ACC),
ON (IG), and ON (READY)) in accordance with shift position, state of
stop light switch and check results of key
Key Cancel Switch
Turns smart key system ON / OFF
Stop Light Switch
Outputs state of brake pedal to power source control ECU
Combination Meter (key warning light)
Certification ECU illuminates key warning light when these conditions
occur:
Key is moved out of vehicle while engine is in operation or key is left in
vehicle, and door lock is operated
Combination Meter (buzzer)
Certification ECU sounds buzzer when these conditions occur:
Key is moved out of vehicle while engine is in operation or key is left in
vehicle, and door lock is operated
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
DL–129
Components
Function
Wireless Door Lock Buzzer
Certification ECU sounds wireless door lock buzzer when these
conditions from occurring:
Key is moved out of vehicle while engine is in operation or key is left in
vehicle, and door lock is operated
Certification ECU
Identifies and check ID codes from door control receiver, then
transmits signals to ECU's if ID codes match.
Upon receiving signals from switches, certification ECU transmits
intermittent transmission request signals to door electrical key
oscillators and transmission request signals to other oscillators in
accordance with conditions.
Power Source Control ECU
Main control of smart key system (for starting).
Receives results of ID code check of key provided by certification ECU
via transponder key ECU.
When check results show that ID code is legitimate, power source
control ECU authorizes transition of power modes through operation
of power switch.
Transponder Key ECU
Main control of engine immobiliser system.
Transmits results of ID code check of key provided by certification
ECU to power source control ECU.
Transmits hybrid system start authorization signal to hybrid vehicle
control ECU.
Transmission Control ECU
Actuates parking lock actuator upon receiving power switch OFF
signal from power source control ECU.
Transmits state of parking lock operation (whether shift position is P or
other position) to power source control ECU.
Hybrid Vehicle Control ECU
Starts hybrid system upon receiving system start signal from power
source control ECU (ON (READY)).
Receives hybrid system start authorization signal from transponder
key ECU.
Main Body ECU
Transmits body control system signals (courtesy switch, door key lock/
unlock switch, door lock position switch, halfway switch signals, etc.)
to certification ECU via BEAN.
Receives door lock/unlock request signal from certification ECU via
dedicated serial communication line (with local protocol), which is
used between main body ECU, certification ECU and door control
receiver.
3.
SYSTEM FUNCTION
(a) Entry unlock
• For the system to be able to detect the location of
the key, the vehicle doors must be locked. The
door oscillators transmit key detection signals at
prescribed intervals in order to form vehicle
exterior detection areas (0.7 to 1.0 m (2.3 to 3.3
ft.)).
• When the key is brought into a detection area,
the system automatically checks the key's ID
code. When this is completed, the door that has
detected the key enters the unlock standby
condition in accordance with the prescribed
unlock mode. In this condition, if the touch
sensor on the outside door handle is touched, all
doors unlock.
Mode
Unlock Standby Door
Door to be Unlocked
One Door Unlock*
Driver
Driver Door Only
One Door Unlock*
Front Passenger
All Doors
One Door Unlock*
Back Door
Back Door Only
All Door Unlock
Driver
All Doors
All Door Unlock
Front Passenger
All Doors
DL
DL–130
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
Mode
Unlock Standby Door
Door to be Unlocked
All Door Unlock
Back Door
All Doors
Driver's Door Unlock
Driver
Driver Door Only
Driver's Door Unlock
Front Passenger
All Doors
Driver's Door Unlock
Back Door
All Doors
HINT:
*: This is the default setting. The entry unlock mode
can be changed by pressing the LOCK and PANIC
switches on the key for approximately 5 seconds.
For details, see CUSTOMIZE PARAMETERS (see
page DL-144).
Touch Sensor
DL
Door Electrical Key
Oscillator
Certification ECU
Key
Door Control Receiver
Vehicle Exterior
Detection Area
Serial Communication
Main Body ECU
Door Lock Motor
B119817E02
DL–131
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
(b) Back door entry unlock
• With all doors locked, if the back door opener
switch is pressed with the key in the user's
possession, the luggage electrical key oscillator
(outer) outputs a key detection signal and the
certification ECU checks the ID code. After the
check is completed, the certification ECU
unlocks* the back door via the main body ECU.
At this time, if the user continues to press the
back door opener switch, the back door lock
latch will be released.
HINT:
*: If entry unlock is set to individual door unlock
mode, only the back door will be unlocked. If set to
all door unlock mode or driver's door unlock mode
(default setting), all doors will be unlocked.
Luggage Electrical Key
Oscillator (Outer)
DL
Key
Certification ECU
Door Control Receiver
Vehicle Exterior
Detection Area
Back Door Opener
Switch
Serial Communication
Main Body ECU
Back Door Lock Motor
B119818E02
HINT:
Handling precaution for back door entry unlock:
Back door entry unlock function may not operate if
the key is placed near the center of the rear bumper.
DL–132
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
(c) Entry lock
• When the key is located outside the vehicle and
all doors are closed, if the user presses the lock
switch on the outside door handle or the lock
switch on the back door, the certification ECU will
actuate all oscillators and start checking for the
ID code of a key.
• At this time, if an oscillator outside the vehicle
(driver's/front passenger's door electrical key
oscillator or luggage electrical key oscillator
(outer)) determines that the key ID code is
legitimate, the certification ECU determines that
the key has been taken outside the vehicle and
locks all doors via the main body ECU.
• An entry unlock operation will not be authorized
for approximately 3 seconds* after the doors
have been locked.
HINT:
*: The setting of this duration can be changed using
the customize function. For details, see
CUSTOMIZE PARAMETERS (see page DL-144).
DL
Luggage Electrical Key
Oscillator (Outer)
Certification ECU
Key
Door Control Receiver
Lock Switch
Vehicle Exterior
Detection Area
Luggage Electrical Key
Oscillator (Inner)
Main Body ECU
Door Lock Motors
Vehicle Exterior
Detection Area
B119819E02
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
DL–133
(d) Entry ignition
OFF → ON (ACC) → ON (IG)
• If the driver presses the power switch once
without depressing the brake pedal, the indoor
electrical key oscillator, in accordance with the
request signal received from the certification
ECU, forms a key detection area inside the
vehicle by emitting key detection signals.
Accordingly, the key sends an ID code signal to
the certification ECU via the door control
receiver. The certification ECU checks the ID
code of the key and transmits the check results
to the transponder key ECU.
• The transponder key ECU transmits the check
results to the power source control ECU. If the
check results show that the ID code is legitimate,
the power source control ECU will turn on the
ACC relay and start the ACC power supply. At
this time, the power source control ECU
illuminates a green indicator light on the power
switch in order to inform the driver of the ON
(ACC) status.
• After the transition to the ON (ACC) status, if the
driver presses the power switch again, the power
source control ECU will turn on the IG1 and IG2
relays and start the IG power supply. At this time,
the power source control ECU illuminates an
amber indicator light on the power switch in order
to inform the driver of the ON (IG) status.
DL
DL–134
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
Power Switch
Power Source
Control ECU
Transponder Key
ECU
ACC Relay
BEAN
DL
IG1 and IG2 Relays
Serial
Communication
Key
Indoor Electrical Key
Oscillator
Certification ECU
Door Control Receiver
Vehicle Interior
Detection Area
BEAN
B119820E02
OFF → ON (READY)
If the driver presses the power switch once while
depressing the brake pedal, the indoor electrical key
oscillator, in accordance with the request signal
received from the certification ECU, forms a key
detection area inside the vehicle by emitting key
detection signals. Accordingly, the key sends an ID
code signal to the certification ECU via the door
control receiver.
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
DL–135
The certification ECU checks the ID code of the key
and transmits the check results to the transponder
key ECU.
The transponder key ECU transmits the check
results to the power source control ECU. If the
check results reveal that the ID code is legitimate,
the power source control ECU will turn on the ACC,
IG1 and IG2 relays and start the ACC and IG power
supply.
At this time, the power source control ECU
illuminates an amber indicator light on the power
switch in order to inform the driver of the ON (IG)
status.
After the indicator light has illuminated, the power
source control ECU transmits a hybrid system start
request signal to the hybrid vehicle control ECU.
Upon receiving this signal, the hybrid vehicle control
ECU verifies the check results of the key ID code
provided by the transponder key ECU.
If the check results reveal that the ID code is
legitimate, the hybrid vehicle control ECU starts the
hybrid system.
At this time, the power source control ECU will turn
off the indicator light on the power switch in order to
inform the driver of the ON (READY) status.
DL
DL–136
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
Key
Indoor Electrical Key
Oscillator
Certification ECU
Door Control Receiver
Vehicle Interior
Detection Area
Serial
Communication
Power Switch
DL
Transponder
Key ECU
Serial Communication
ID Code Check Results
ACC Relay
Power Source
Control ECU
BEAN
Stop Light Switch
Gateway ECU
Hybrid Vehicle
Control ECU
CAN
IG1 and IG2 Relays
READY Signal
Hybrid System Start
Request READY Signal
CAN
BEAN
B119821E02
(e) Warning function
• General
The smart key system is equipped with a warning
function to prevent problems resulting from
errors in key usage. The smart key system works
without any requirements other than having the
key in the user's possession. The user, as a
result, may become unaware of the presence or
location of the key and make errors (listed below)
that could lead to serious problems.
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
DL–137
EXAMPLES:
• The driver is unaware that the key has been
taken out of the vehicle by a passenger.
• The driver exits the vehicle with the hybrid
system running.
• The driver exits the vehicle with the shift position
not on P.
If the above situations occur, the hybrid system may
be unable to be started after it has been turned off,
the vehicle may be stolen, or other problems may
result. Warning function descriptions for several key
usage errors are below.
(1) Warning against the driver taking the key outside
the vehicle with the shift position on P:
Possible results without warning
Vehicle theft or inability to restart hybrid system
Detection conditions
If all conditions listed below are met and key ID code check result by
room oscillator fails, warning will be issued:
• Shift position is P
• Power switch is not OFF
• Driver side door is opened and closed
Warning (Key warning light)
Illuminates upon detection and turns OFF if power switch is turned
OFF or key ID code check result by indoor electrical key oscillator
passes.
Warning (buzzer (combination meter))
Sounds once upon detection. Sounds again if vehicle driven in this
state.
Warning (wireless door lock buzzer)
Sounds 3 times upon detection and stops if power switch is turned
OFF or key ID code check result by indoor electrical key oscillator
passes
(2) Warning against the driver taking the key outside
the vehicle while the shift position is not on P:
Possible results without warning
Vehicle theft or inability to restart hybrid system
Detection conditions
If all conditions listed below are met and key ID code check result by
indoor electrical key oscillator fails, warning will be issued:
• Shift position is not P
• Power switch is ON (ACC), ON (IG) or ON (READY)
• Driver side door is opened and closed
Warning (Key warning light)
•
•
Illuminates upon detection and turns OFF if power switch is turned
OFF or key ID code check result by indoor electrical key oscillator
passes
Warning message is displayed on multi-display
Warning (buzzer (combination meter))
Sounds continuously upon detection and stops if power switch is
turned OFF, shift position is changed to P, or key ID code check result
by indoor electrical key oscillator passes
Warning (wireless door lock buzzer)
Sounds continuously upon detection and stops if power switch is
turned OFF, shift position is changed to P, or key ID code check result
by indoor electrical key oscillator passes
(3) Warning against a passenger taking the key
outside the vehicle:
Possible results without warning
Inability to restart hybrid system
Detection conditions
If all conditions listed below are met and key ID code check result by
indoor electrical key oscillator fails, warning will be issued:
• Power switch is not OFF
• Door other than driver side door is opened and closed
Warning (Key warning light)
Illuminates upon detection and turns OFF if power switch is turned
OFF or key ID code check result by indoor electrical key oscillator
passes
Warning (buzzer (combination meter))
Sounds once upon detection. Sounds again if vehicle is driven in this
state.
DL
DL–138
Warning (wireless door lock buzzer)
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
Sounds 3 times upon detection and stops if power switch is turned
OFF or key ID code check result by indoor electrical key oscillator
passes.
(4) Warning against operating the entry lock with the
hybrid system operating:
Possible results without warning
Vehicle theft or inability to restart hybrid system
Detection conditions
If all conditions listed below are met, key ID code check result by
indoor electrical key oscillator fails, and key ID code check by door
electrical key oscillator passes, warning will be issued:
• Shift position is P
• Power switch is not OFF
• All doors are closed
• Lock switch on outside door handle is ON
Warning (Key warning light)
Illuminates upon detection and turns OFF if power switch is turned
OFF or key ID code check result by indoor electrical key oscillator
passes
Warning (buzzer (combination meter))
-
Warning (wireless door lock buzzer)
Sounds for 2 seconds
(5) Warning against operating the door lock while
the key remains in the vehicle:
DL
Possible results without warning
Vehicle theft
Detection conditions
If all conditions listed below are met and key ID code check result by
indoor electrical key oscillator passes, warning will be issued:
• Power switch is OFF
• All doors are closed
• Lock switch on outside door handle is ON
Warning (Key warning light)
-
Warning (buzzer (combination meter))
-
Warning (wireless door lock buzzer)
Sounds for 2 seconds
(6) Warning against low battery of the key:
Possible results without warning
Entry control is suddenly disabled
Detection conditions
If condition listed below is met, and certification ECU receives code
indicating voltage drop of key battery while indoor electrical key
oscillator checks key ID code:
The power switch has been turned OFF after 20 or more minutes have
elapsed after hybrid system has been started.
Warning (Key warning light)
-
Warning (buzzer (combination meter))
Sounds once upon detection
Warning (wireless door lock buzzer)
-
(7) Warning against operating the entry ignition
outside the detection area of the indoor electrical
key oscillator:
Possible results without warning
User is confused
Detection conditions
If condition listed below is met and key ID code check result by indoor
electrical key oscillator fails, warning will be issued:
Power switch is pushed
Warning (Key warning light)
Illuminates for 5 seconds upon detection
Warning (buzzer (combination meter))
Sounds once upon detection
Warning (wireless door lock buzzer)
-
(8) Warning against operating the door lock while
any of the doors is open:
Possible results without warning
Vehicle theft
DL–139
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
Detection conditions
If all conditions listed below are met, warning will be issued:
• Power switch is OFF
• Any door is open
• Lock switch on outside door handle is ON
Warning (Key warning light)
-
Warning (buzzer (combination meter))
-
Warning (wireless door lock buzzer)
Sounds for 10 seconds and stops when 10 seconds have passed or if
any door is closed
(f)
Entry unlock mode selector function
• When the power switch is OFF, and the key's
LOCK switch and PANIC switch remain pressed
for approximately 5 seconds, the entry unlock
mode can be changed between the following:
individual door unlock, driver's door unlock, all
doors unlock and individual door unlock.
• The wireless door lock buzzer informs the user of
the entry unlock mode. Refer to the chart below.
DL
Unlock Mode
Wireless Door Lock Buzzer
Buzzer
(in Combination Meter)
Sounds once
One Door
All Doors
Sounds once
Driver’s Door
(Default Setting)
Sounds once
1 second
B119822E01
NOTICE:
• This function only changes the unlocking
modes of the smart key system. It does not
affect the wireless door lock control system.
• When changing modes, be sure to push the
LOCK switch and PANIC switch firmly, or the
panic alarm may activate.
DL–140
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
(g) Power saving function
• When the doors are locked, the door electrical
key oscillators emit signals to the outside of the
vehicle at default intervals. To avoid depleting the
auxiliary battery, the system has a power saving
function whereby: 1) after 5 days without a
response from the key, the system extends door
electrical key oscillator signal intervals; and 2)
after 14 days without a response from the key,
the system deactivates the smart key system.
• When the doors are locked and the key is located
within the vehicle exterior detection area, the key
and door electrical key oscillators are maintaining
communication and using power. To avoid
depleting the key battery and auxiliary battery, if
the key is located within the vehicle exterior
detection area for longer than 10 minutes, the
system deactivates the smart key system.
Refer to the chart below for information on how to
reinstate the smart key system.
DL
Condition
Control
Reinstatement Condition
Vehicle remains parked for a long time.
No response from key for more than 5 days
Extends signal transmission interval
•
•
•
Vehicle remains parked for a long time.
No response from key for more than 14 days
Automatically deactivates smart key system
•
•
•
Vehicle remains parked for a long time.
Key is located in vehicle exterior detection
area for longer than 10 minutes
Automatically deactivates smart key system
•
•
•
Wireless door lock control signal (lock or
unlock) is input and ID code matches
Lock switch signal is input
Door is locked or unlocked in unison with
movement of mechanical key
Wireless door lock control signal (lock or
unlock) is input and ID code matches
Lock switch signal is input
Door is locked or unlocked in unison with
movement of mechanical key
Wireless door lock control signal (lock or
unlock) is input and ID code matches
Lock switch signal is input
Door is locked or unlocked in unison with
movement of mechanical key
DL–141
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
• Use these procedures to troubleshoot the smart key
system.
*: Use the intelligent tester.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
INSPECT BATTERY VOLTAGE
Standard voltage:
11 to 14 V
If the voltage is below 11 V, recharge or replace the battery
before proceeding.
NEXT
3
CHECK COMMUNICATION FUNCTION OF MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
(BEAN)*
(a) Use the intelligent tester to check if the multiplex
communication system (MPX) is functioning normally.
Result
Result
Proceed to
MPX DTC is not output
A
MPX DTC is output
B
B
Go to MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION
SYSTEM
A
4
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(a) Refer to the problem symptoms table (see page DL145).
Result:
Result
Proceed to
Fault is not listed in problem symptoms table
A
Fault is listed in problem symptoms table
B
B
A
Go to step 6
DL
DL–142
5
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
OVERALL ANALYSIS AND TROUBLESHOOTING*
(a) On-vehicle inspection (see page DL-155)
(b) DATA LIST/ACTIVE TEST (see page DL-153)
(c) Terminals of ECU (see page DL-146)
NEXT
6
NEXT
END
DL
REPAIR OR REPLACE
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
DL–143
REGISTRATION
1.
2.
System state
DESCRIPTION OF REGISTRATION: PROCEDURE 1
HINT:
• Entry codes (wireless key codes) are the same as
recognition codes for the wireless transmitter.
Registering an entry key code enables both the smart
key system and the wireless door lock control system
to be operated.
• Code registration is necessary when the certification
ECU or key is replaced.
(a) Select a mode from the following:
• New registration mode:
New registration mode is used when the
certification ECU is replaced with a new ECU.
• Add mode:
Add mode is used when a new key is added.
• Communication mode:
Communication mode is used to confirm the
number of codes currently registered. Use the
first screen of the key registration option.
• Erasure mode:
Erasure mode is used to erase all the key codes
except for the code for the master key that is
used during erasure mode. Use this mode when
a key is lost.
(b) Perform code registration and code erasure
according to the flowcharts (see PROCEDURE 2
and 3).
HINT:
• A total of 5 keys can be registered.
• When registering a transmitter, do not have any
other transmitters close to the transmitter being
registered. The certification ECU may be unable
to recognize which transmitter is sending signals.
REGISTRATION OF NEW AND ADDITIONAL ENTRY
KEY CODE: PROCEDURE 2
(a) Register an entry key code using the intelligent
tester.
State switching condition
Go to
1. Start
-
-
2. Vehicle should be in the following condition
New registration mode.
1. Master key is in key slot
2. Power switch is ON (IG)
3. Intelligent tester operation
Add mode.
Power switch is ON (IG)
3. Intelligent tester operation
1. Select PRIUS from menu.
2. Select SMART KEY SYSTEM.
3. Select ID UTILITY.
4. Select SMART CODE REG.
HINT:
Perform operation according to prompts on
tester screen and make sure that operation is
finished without errors.
4. Check if it is new registration or additional
registration
DL
DL–144
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
System state
State switching condition
Go to
4. Check if it is new registration or additional
registration
New registration mode (when certification
ECU is new).
6. Key (transmitter) switch operation
Add mode (when master key is already
registered).
5. Master key (transmitter) switch operation
5. Master key (transmitter) switch operation
Press any one of the transmitter's switches.
HINT:
This operation should be performed with
already registered master key.
6. Key (transmitter) switch operation
6. Key (transmitter) switch operation
(Within 30 seconds)
HINT:
• Perform this operation with key that will
be newly registered. If no keys have been
registered, register master key first in new
registration mode.
• When key code is registered, interactive
communication is performed between key
and certification ECU through indoor
electrical key oscillator. Electrical key
oscillator's reception is best in front seat
area.
• Interactive communication between the
key and the ECU may take several
seconds. The amount of time from switch
operation to response is approximately 2
seconds.
• In new registration mode, turn power
switch OFF and then remove master key
from key slot.
1. Press the LOCK and UNLOCK switches
on transmitter simultaneously.
2. Within 3 seconds of the previous step,
press any one of the switches.
Wireless door lock buzzer sounds when
registration is completed without errors.
7. Register other key codes or finish the
registration
7. Register other key codes or finish the
registration
Register other key codes.
Continue registration.
HINT:
Select the next step on the tester screen.
5. Master key (transmitter) switch operation
Finish the registration.
End
DL
HINT:
• A brief outline of procedures for key code
registration is shown above. For more detailed
information, please refer to the intelligent tester
screen's instructions.
• The number of currently registered codes can be
checked on the first screen of the key code
registration option.
3.
ERASURE OF ENTRY KEY CODE: PROCEDURE 3
(a) Erase an entry key code using the intelligent tester.
System state
State switching condition
Go to
1. Start
-
-
2. Vehicle should be in the following condition
Power switch is ON (IG)
3. Intelligent tester operation
3. Intelligent tester operation
1.
2.
3.
4.
4. Master key (transmitter) switch operation
4. Master key (transmitter) switch operation
This operation should be performed with
already registered master key.
Press any one of transmitter's switches.
Select PRIUS from menu.
Select SMART KEY SYSTEM.
Select ID UTILITY.
Select SMART CODE ERS.
5. Intelligent tester operation
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
System state
State switching condition
Go to
5. Intelligent tester operation
After above switch operation, operating tester
according to tester screen instructions erases
codes except codes of master key used in
previous step.
End
DL–145
HINT:
A brief outline of procedures for key code erasure is
shown above. For more detailed information, please
refer to the intelligent tester screen's instructions.
DL
DL–146
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
CUSTOMIZE PARAMETERS
HINT:
The items in the table on the next page can be customized.
NOTICE:
• When the customer request a change in a function,
first make sure that the function(s) can be customized.
• Be sure to record the current setting before
customizing.
• When troubleshooting a function, first make sure that
the function is not set to OFF.
Smart key system
DL
Display (Item)
Default
Contents
Setting
SMART WARN 1
(Warns if key is taken from Ddoor with P position)
ON
Function that warns driver that
key is taken out from driver's door
when shift position is P and power
switch is not OFF
ON / OFF
SMART WARN 2
(Warns if key is taken from Ddoor without P position)
ON
Function that warns driver that
key is taken out from driver's door
when shift position is not P and
power switch is not OFF
ON / OFF
SMART WARN 3
(Warns if key is taken out by other
passengers)
ON
Function that warns driver that
key is taken out from front
passenger's door by passenger
when power switch is not OFF
ON / OFF
SMART BUZ NUM
(Sets number of warning buzzer
sounds)
3 TIMES
Function that sets number of
warning buzzer sounds when key
is taken out of vehicle
OFF / 3TIMES / 5TIMES /
7TIMES
SMART WARN 4
(Warning time for locking door
when engine is idling)
2s
Function that sets warning time
for locking doors while engine is
idling
OFF / 1s / 2s
SMART WARN 5
(Warning when key is left in
vehicle)
2s
Function that sets warning time
for locking doors while key is
inside vehicle
OFF / 1s/ 2s
SMART WARN 6
(Warning if starting engine when
key is out of detection range)
ON
Function that warns driver that
entry ignition control is being
attempted to be activated while
key is out of detection range
ON / OFF
KEY LOW-BATT WRN
(Warning when key battery
becomes weak)
ON
Function that warns driver that
key's battery power is low
ON / OFF
SMART UNLOCK
(Entry door unlock mode)
EACH
Function that makes entry unlock
operation available.
ALL / EACH / D-door
TRANSMIT INTVAL
(Transmission interval)
0.3s
Function that sets entry signal
transmission intervals when
vehicle is stopped and key is
outside vehicle
0.15s / 0.3s / 0.45s / 0.6s
PARK WAIT TIME
(Waiting time to permit door
opening of door after locking)
3.0s
Function that sets waiting time to
permit opening door after door is
locked with entry lock function
0.5s / 1.5s / 2.5s / 5s
SMART BACK DOOR
(Back door opening operation
when vehicle is locked)
LONG
Function that enables back door
to open when key is inside
luggage room
LONG / TWICE / OFF
DL–147
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
Use the table below to help determine the cause of the
problem symptom. The potential causes of the symptoms are
listed in order of probability in the "Suspected area" column of
the table. Check each symptom by checking the suspected
areas in the order they are listed. Replace parts as
necessary.
Smart key system
Symptom
Entry Functions do not Operate at All
Key Cancel Switch does not Operate
Key Warning Light does not Come ON
Driver Side Door Entry Unlock Function does not
Operate
Front Passenger Side Door Entry Unlock Function
does not Operate
Driver Side Door Entry Lock and Unlock Functions do
not Operate
Front Passenger Side Door Entry Lock and Unlock
functions do not Operate
Driver Side Door Entry Lock Function does not
Operate
Entry Lock Function does not Operate Front
Passenger Side Door
Vehicle is not Ready to Start when Driver Has Key
Suspected area
See page
1. Wireless door lock control system
DL-187
2. Key cancel switch
DL-187
3. Certification ECU
DL-187
4. Wire harness
DL-187
1. Wireless door lock control system
DL-159
2. Key cancel switch
DL-159
3. Certification ECU
DL-159
4. Wire harness
DL-159
1. Certification ECU
DL-185
2. Combination meter
DL-185
3. Wire harness
DL-185
1. Power door lock control system
DL-162
2. Door electrical key oscillator LH
DL-162
3. Outside door handle front LH
DL-162
4. Certification ECU
DL-162
5. Wire harness
DL-162
1. Power door lock control system
DL-167
2. Door electrical key oscillator RH
DL-167
3. Outside door handle front RH
DL-167
4. Certification ECU
DL-167
5. Wire harness
DL-167
1. Power door lock control system
DL-172
2. Door electrical key oscillator LH
DL-172
3. Certification ECU
DL-172
4. Wire harness
DL-172
1. Power door lock control system
DL-174
2. Door electrical key oscillator RH
DL-174
3. Certification ECU
DL-174
4. Wire Harness
DL-174
1. Power door lock control system
DL-176
2. Outside door handle front LH
DL-176
3. Certification ECU
DL-176
4. Wire harness
DL-176
1. Power door lock control system
DL-179
2. Outside door handle front RH
DL-179
3. Certification ECU
DL-179
4. Wire harness
DL-179
1. Indoor electrical key oscillator
DL-189
2. Certification ECU
DL-189
3. Key (transmitter)
DL-189
4. Wire harness
DL-189
DL
DL–148
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
Symptom
Back Door Entry Unlock Function does not Operate
Key Luggage Compartment Lock-in Prevention
Function does not Operate
DL
Suspected area
See page
1. Luggage electrical key oscillator (outer)
DL-193
2. Back door opener switch
DL-193
3. Luggage antenna
DL-193
4. Certification ECU
DL-193
5. Wire harness
DL-193
1. Luggage electrical key oscillator (inner)
DL-182
2. Certification ECU
DL-182
3. Wire harness
DL-182
DL–149
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
CHECK CERTIFICATION ECU
S11
17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10
9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18
B119823E01
(a) Disconnect the S11 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance and voltage of the wire
harness side connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
+B1 (S11-1) - Body
ground
R - Body ground
+B power supply
Always
10 to 14 V
IG (S11-18) - Body ground
B - Body ground
Ignition power supply
Power switch OFF
Below 1 V
IG (S11-18) - Body ground
B - Body ground
Ignition power supply
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
E (S11-17) - Body ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
TSW1 (S11-5) - Body
ground
B - Body ground
Outside door handle LH
lock switch signal
Lock switch OFF
10 kΩ or higher
TSW1 (S11-5) - Body
ground
B - Body ground
Outside door handle LH
lock switch signal
Lock switch ON
Below 1 Ω
TSW2 (S11-6) - Body
ground
R - Body ground
Outside door handle RH
lock switch signal
Lock switch OFF
10 kΩ or higher
TSW2 (S11-6) - Body
ground
R - Body ground
Outside door handle RH
lock switch signal
Lock switch ON
Below 1 Ω
TSW6 (S11-8) - Body
ground
B - Body ground
Back door lock switch
signal
Back door lock switch OFF
10 kΩ or higher
TSW6 (S11-8) - Body
ground
B - Body ground
Back door lock switch
signal
Back door lock switch ON
Below 1 Ω
CNSL (S11-25) - Body
ground
W-B - Body ground
Key cancel switch signal
Key cancel switch OFF
10 kΩ or higher
CNSL (S11-25) - Body
ground
W-B - Body ground
Key cancel switch signal
Key cancel switch ON
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
(c) Reconnect the S11 ECU connector.
(d) Measure the voltage of the connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
CLG1 (S11-13) - E (S1117)
P - W-B
Driver door electrical key
oscillator sensor signal
All doors closed, all doors
locked and power switch
OFF
Alternating between 5 V
and below 1 V
CLG1 (S11-13) - E (S1117)
P - W-B
Driver door electrical key
oscillator sensor signal
Door unlocked or door
open
Below 1 V
CLG2 (S11-14) - E (S1117)
R - W-B
Front passenger door
electrical key oscillator
sensor signal
All doors closed, all doors
locked and power switch
OFF
Alternating between 5 V
and below 1 V
CLG2 (S11-14) - E (S1117
R - W-B
Front passenger door
electrical key oscillator
sensor signal
Door unlocked or door
open
Below 1 V
DL
DL–150
DL
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
CLG5 (S11-36) - E (S1117)
G - W-B
Indoor electrical key
oscillator sensor signal
30 seconds after driver
side door opened and
closed, power switch OFF
Alternating between 5 V
and below 1 V
CLG5 (S11-36) - E (S1117)
G - W-B
Indoor electrical key
oscillator sensor signal
Within 30 seconds after
driver side door opened
and closed, power switch
ON (IG)
Below 1 V
CLG7 (S11-38) - E (S1117)
BR - W-B
Luggage electrical key
oscillator inner sensor
signal
Back door opener switch
OFF
Alternating between 5 V
and below 1 V
CLG7 (S11-38) - E (S1117)
BR - W-B
Luggage electrical key
oscillator inner sensor
signal
Back door opener switch
ON
Below 1 V
CLG8 (S11-39) - E (S1117)
O - W-B
Luggage electrical key
oscillator outer sensor
signal
Back door opener switch
OFF
Alternating between 5 V
and below 1 V
CLG8 (S11-39) - E (S1117)
O - W-B
Luggage electrical key
oscillator outer sensor
signal
Back door opener switch
ON
Below 1 V
SEL1 (S11-23) - E (S1117)
Y - W-B
Touch sensor activation
control signal
Key at least 3 m (9.8 ft.)
away from closed and
locked door
10 to 14 V
SEL1 (S11-23) - E (S1117)
Y - W-B
Touch sensor activation
control signal
Key is near closed and
locked door
Below 1 V
SEL2 (S11-24) - E (S1117)
B - W-B
Touch sensor activation
control signal
Key at least 3 m (9.8 ft.)
away from closed and
locked door
10 to 14 V
SEL2 (S11-24) - E (S1117)
B - W-B
Touch sensor activation
control signal
Key is near closed and
locked door
Below 1 V
SEN1 (S11-21) - E (S1117)
R - W-B
Touch sensor detection
signal
Outside door handle LH
touched
10 to 14 V
SEN1 (S11-21) - E (S1117)
R - W-B
Touch sensor detection
signal
Outside door handle LH
not touched
Below 1 V
SEN2 (S11-22) - E (S1117)
W - W-B
Touch sensor detection
signal
Outside door handle RH
touched
10 to 14 V
SEN2 (S11-22) - E (S1117)
W - W-B
Touch sensor detection
signal
Outside door handle RH
not touched
Below 1 V
RDA3 (S11-29) - E (S1117)
L - W-B
Door control receiver input
signal
With power switch OFF, no
key and all doors closed
Below 1 V
RDA3 (S11-29) - E (S1117)
L - W-B
Door control receiver input
signal
With power switch OFF, all
doors closed and key is
moved (outside of vehicle
exterior detection area →
inside of detection area)
Approx. 6 to 7 V
PRG (S11-28) - E (S1117)
B - W-B
Door control receiver
output signal
With power switch OFF, no
key and all doors closed
Below 1 V
PRG (S11-28) - E (S1117)
B - W-B
Door control receiver
output signal
With power switch OFF, all
doors closed and key is
moved (outside of vehicle
exterior detection area →
inside of detection area)
Approx. 6 to 7 V
RCO (S11-12) - E (S1117)
L - W-B
Power source
With power switch OFF, no
key and doors closed
0 to 5 V
RCO (S11-12) - E (S1117)
L - W-B
Power source
With power switch OFF, all
doors closed and key is
moved (outside of vehicle
exterior detection area →
inside of detection area)
5V
RSSI (S11-11) - E (S1117)
V - W-B
Door control receiver
output signal
With power switch OFF, no
key and all doors closed
0 to 5 V
DL–151
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
RSSI (S11-11) - E (S1117)
V - W-B
Door control receiver
output signal
With power switch OFF, all
doors closed and key is
moved (outside of vehicle
exterior detection area →
inside of detection area)
Below 1 V
RDA (S11-10) - E (S11-17)
GR - W-B
Door control receiver input
signal
With power switch OFF, no
key and all doors closed
Below 1 V
RDA (S11-10) - E (S11-17)
GR - W-B
Door control receiver input
signal
With power switch OFF, all
doors closed and key is
moved (outside of vehicle
exterior detection area →
inside of detection area)
Approx. 6 to 7 V
KSW (S11-4) - E (S11-17)
Y - W-B
Halfway switch input
signal
No key in key slot
10 to 14 V
KSW (S11-4) - E (S11-17
Y - W-B
Halfway switch input
signal
Key inserted
Below 1 V
If the result is not as specified, the ECU may have a
malfunction.
DL
DL–152
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
2.
CHECK DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK (MAIN
BODY ECU)
B7
1A
1E
1B
DL
Main Body ECU
1A
1
2
19
20
3
4
5
6
7
8
21
22
23
24
25
26
9
10
27
28
11
12
29
30
13
14
15
16
17
18
31
32
33
34
35
36
1E
1
2
17
18
3
4
5
6
7
8
19
20
21
22
23
24
9
10
25
26
11
12
27
28
13
14
15
16
29
30
31
32
B7
1B
6
1
5
4
3
2
17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9
26 25 24 23
1
8 7
22 21 20 19 18
B119824E02
(a) Disconnect the 1A, 1B and 1E junction block
connectors.
DL–153
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
(b) Measure the voltage and resistance of the wire
harness side connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
ECUB (1A-30) - Body
ground
R - Body ground
+B (ECUB) power supply
Always
10 to 14 V
ALTB (1B-1) - Body
ground
W - Body ground
+B (power system,
generator system) power
supply
Always
10 to 14 V
GND (1E-17) - Body
ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
(c) Reconnect the 1A, 1B and 1E junction block
connectors.
(d) Measure the voltage of the connectors.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
PRG (B7-24) - GND (1E17)
B - W-B
Door control receiver
output signal
With power switch OFF, no
key and all doors closed
0 to 5 V
PRG (B7-24) - GND (1E17)
B - W-B
Door control receiver
output signal
With power switch OFF, all
doors closed and key is
moved (outside of vehicle
exterior detection area →
inside of detection area)
Below 1 V
RDA (B7-23) - GND (1E17)
L - W-B
Door control receiver input
signal
With power switch OFF, no
key and all doors closed
Below 1 V
RDA (B7-23) - GND (1E17)
L - W-B
Door control receiver input
signal
With power switch OFF, all
doors closed and key is
moved (outside of vehicle
exterior detection area →
inside of detection area)
Approx. 6 to 7 V
3.
DL
If the result is not as specified, the body ECU may
have a malfunction.
CHECK TRANSPONDER KEY ECU
T5
9 8 7 6
5 4 3 2 1
24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10
B126056E01
(a) Disconnect the T5 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance and voltage of the wire
harness side connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
CPUB (T5-3) - GND (T522)
L - W-B
Battery
Always
10 to 14 V
IG (T5-4) - GND (T5-22)
O - W-B
Power switch (IG)
Power switch OFF
Below 1 V
IG (T5-4) - GND (T5-22)
O - W-B
Power switch (IG)
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
CUWS (T5-5) - GND (T522)
B - W-B
Halfway switch
No key in key slot
10 kΩ or higher
DL–154
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
CUWS (T5-5) - GND (T522)
B - W-B
Halfway switch
Key inserted
Below 1 Ω
AGND (T5-7) - GND (T522)
P - W-B
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
GND (T5-22) - Body
ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
(c) Reconnect the T5 ECU connector.
(d) Measure the voltage of the connector.
DL
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
CUWS (T5-5) -GND (T522)
B - W-B
Halfway switch
No key in key slot
10 to 14 V
CUWS (T5-5) -GND (T522)
B - W-B
Halfway switch
Key inserted
Below 1 V
VC5 (T5-20) - GND (T522)
Y - W-B
Power source
No key in key slot
Below 1 V
VC5 (T5-20) - GND (T522)
Y - W-B
Power source
Key inserted
4.6 to 5.4 V
CODE (T5-21) - AGND
(T5-7)
L-P
Transponder key amplifier
communication signal
No key in key slot → Key
inserted
Pulse generation (see
waveform 1)
TXCT (T5-6) - AGND (T57)
LG - P
Transponder key amplifier
communication signal
No key in key slot → Key
inserted
Pulse generation (see
waveform 2)
HEV0 (T5-19) - GND (T522)
W - W-B
Hybrid vehicle control
ECU output signal
No key in key slot → Key
inserted
Pulse generation (see
waveform 3)
HEV1 (T5-18) - GND (T522)
R - W-B
Hybrid vehicle control
ECU input signal
Always
Pulse generation (see
waveform 4)
If the result is not as specified, the ECU may have a
malfunction.
(e) Inspect using an oscilloscope.
Waveform 1 (Reference)
Waveform 1 (Reference)
B051052E05
Item
Content
Symbols (Terminal No.)
TXCT (T5-6) - GND (T5-22)
Tool Setting
2.0 V/DIV., 10 msec./DIV.
Condition
Key inserted
DL–155
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
(f)
Waveform 2 (Reference)
Inspect using an oscilloscope.
Waveform 2 (Reference)
Item
Content
Symbols (Terminal No.)
CODE (T5-21) - GND (T5-22)
Tool Setting
2.0 V/DIV., 10 msec./DIV.
Condition
Key inserted
B051053E06
(g) Inspect using an oscilloscope.
Waveform 3 (Reference)
Waveform 3 (Reference)
Item
Content
Symbols (Terminal No.)
HEV0 (T5-19) - GND (T5-22)
Tool Setting
10 V/DIV., 100 msec./DIV.
Condition
Power switch ON (IG)
B051050E04
(h) Inspect using an oscilloscope.
Waveform 4 (Reference)
Waveform 4 (Reference)
B051051E05
Item
Content
Symbols (Terminal No.)
HEV1 (T5-18) - GND (T5-22)
Tool Setting
10 V/DIV., 100 msec./DIV.
Condition
Always
DL
DL–156
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
1.
DESCRIPTION
(a) The certification ECU controls the function of the
smart key system on the vehicle. Data of the smart
key system and Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs)
can be read in the Data Link Connector 3 (DLC3) of
the vehicle. When the system seems to be
malfunctioning, use the intelligent tester to check for
a malfunction and perform repairs.
2.
CHECK DLC3
(a) The vehicle uses the ISO 15765-4 communication
protocol. The terminal arrangement of the DLC3
complies with SAE J1962 and matches the ISO
15765-4 format.
CG SG CANH SIL
DL
CANL
BAT
H100769E16
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
SIL (7) - SG (5)
Bus "+" line
During transmission
Pulse generation
CG (4) - Body ground
Chassis ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
SG (5) - Body ground
Signal ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
BAT (16) - Body ground
Battery positive
Always
10 to 14 V
CANH (6) - CANL (14)
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Power switch OFF*
54 to 69 Ω
CANH (6) - CG (4)
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Power switch OFF*
1 kΩ or more
CANL (14) - CG (4)
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Power switch OFF*
1 kΩ or more
CANH (6) - BAT (16)
LOW-level CAN bus line
Power switch OFF*
1 MΩ or more
CANL (14) - BAT (16)
LOW-level CAN bus line
Power switch OFF*
1 MΩ or more
Intelligent Tester
DLC3
CAN VIM
A082795E10
NOTICE:
*: Before measuring the resistance, leave the vehicle as
is for at least 1 minute and do not operate the power
switch, any other switches or the doors.
If the result is not as specified, the DLC3 may have a
malfunction. Repair or replace the harness and connector.
HINT:
Connect the cable of the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to
the DLC3, turn the power switch ON (IG) and attempt to use
the tester. If the display informs that a communication error
has occurred, there is a problem either with the vehicle or
with the tester.
• If communication is normal when the tester is connected to
another vehicle, inspect the DLC3 of the original vehicle.
• If communication is still impossible when the tester is
connected to another vehicle, the problem is probably in
the tester itself. Consult the Service Department listed in
the tester's instruction manual.
DL–157
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST
1.
READ DATA LIST
HINT:
Using the intelligent tester's DATA LIST allows switch,
sensor, actuator and other item values to be read without
removing any parts. Reading the DATA LIST early in
troubleshooting is one way to save time.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and press the
intelligent tester main switch ON.
(c) Read the DATA LIST according to the display on the
tester.
Certification ECU
Item
Measurement Item/Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
D TOUCH SENSOR
D-door touch sensor/
ON or OFF
ON: Sensor is being touched
OFF: Sensor is not being touched
P TOUCH SENSOR
P-door touch sensor/
ON or OFF
ON: Sensor is being touched
OFF: Sensor is not being touched
D TRIGGER SW
D-door trigger switch/
ON or OFF
ON: Lock switch is being pushed
OFF: Lock switch is not being
pushed
P TRIGGER SW
P-door trigger switch/
ON or OFF
ON: Lock switch is being pushed
OFF: Lock switch is not being
pushed
TR/B-DOOR LOCK
Trunk/Back-door lock switch/
ON or OFF
ON: Back door lock switch is
being pushed
OFF: Back door lock switch is not
being pushed
SMART CANCEL SW
Key cancel switch/
ON or OFF
ON: Key cancel switch is ON
OFF: Key cancel switch is OFF
KEY UNLK WRN SW
Key unlock warning switch/
ON or OFF
ON: Key is in key slot
OFF: No key is in key slot
IG SW
Power switch/
ON or OFF
ON: Power switch is ON (IG)
OFF: Power switch is OFF
2.
Diagnostic Note
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST
HINT:
Performing the intelligent tester's ACTIVE TEST allows
relay, VSV, actuator and other items to be operated
without removing any parts. Performing the ACTIVE
TEST early in troubleshooting is one way to save time.
The DATA LIST can be displayed during the ACTIVE
TEST.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and press the
intelligent tester main switch ON.
(c) Perform the ACTIVE TEST according to the display
on the tester.
Certification ECU
Item
Test Details
D TRANSMITTER
Driver side transmitter
ON / OFF
P TRANSMITTER
Front passenger side transmitter
ON / OFF
Diagnostic Note
DL
DL–158
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
Item
Test Details
FR TRANSMITTER
Indoor electrical key oscillator (front)
ON / OFF
Diagnostic Note
IN BDR TRNSMTTR
Back door inner transmitter
ON / OFF
BDOOR TRNSMTTR
Back door outer transmitter
ON / OFF
D SELECT SIG
Driver side select
ON / OFF
P SELECT SIG
Front passenger side select
ON / OFF
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
70 cm or More
DL
B080564E01
Lock Switch
Detection Area
Glove
B080440E01
SMART KEY SYSTEM OPERATION INSPECTION
(a) Check entry door unlock function.
(1) Use the wireless lock operation to lock doors.
With the key in your possession, touch a door's
outside handle (touch sensor) and check that
the door unlocks.
(b) Check the entry door unlock operation's detection
area.
(1) Step 1: Hold the key at the same height as the
door's outside handle (approximately 0.8 m
(2.6 ft.)).
(2) Step 2: Pay attention to the direction of the key
in the illustration on the left. Check that when
the key is brought within 0.7 to 1.0 m (2.3 to 3.3
ft.) of the vehicle, the system enters unlock
standby mode.
HINT:
Unlock standby mode is signified by the key's
red LED illuminating.
(3) Step 3: Once the system enters unlock standby
mode, touch the outside handle's sensor within
3 seconds. Check that the door unlocks.
NOTICE:
The key cannot communicate with the
system within a 0.2 m (0.6 ft.) radius of each
outside handle.
(4) Step 4: Repeat step 2 and step 3 for the
remaining doors.
(5) Step 5: Inspect the door electrical key
oscillator's response sensitivity. Wear
protective gloves, set the system to unlock
standby mode, and check that touching the
inner side of the outside handle (the highlighted
area in the illustration) with two fingers causes
the door to unlock.
NOTICE:
When touching the highlighted area,
tapping too quickly or having extended
contact may not trigger the sensor. In such
a case, the door will not unlock.
(6) Step 6: Repeat step 5 for the remaining doors.
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
DL–159
(c) Check entry door lock function.
(1) Step 1: Close all of the vehicle's doors. With the
key in your possession outside of the vehicle,
check that pressing the lock switch locks front
doors.
Approx.
30 cm
B080569E01
70 cm or More
Center of Vehicle
B080570E01
(2) Step 2: Inspect the entry door lock operation's
detection area and the indoor electrical key
oscillator for wave leaks. Hold the key at a
height of 1 m (3.3 ft.) above the lower edge of
the window frame). Pay attention to the
direction and position of the key in the
illustration on the left. Check that when the key
is approximately 0.3 m (0.9 ft.) from the vehicle
and the lock switch is pressed, the front doors
lock and the warning buzzer (for when the key
is forgotten) does not sound. If the warning
buzzer sounds, the indoor electrical key
oscillator may have a wave leak.
HINT:
Due to the key being unable to communicate
with the system within a 0.2 m (0.6 ft.) distance
from the outside handle, do not press the lock
switch with the same hand that is holding the
key. The doors will not lock.
(3) Step 3: Repeat step 1 and step 2 for the
remaining doors.
(d) Check entry back door open function.
(1) Close the back door. With the key in your
possession, check that pressing the back door
opener switch opens the back door.
(2) Inspect the entry back door open operation's
detection area. Hold the key at the same height
as the back door opener switch (approximately
0.8 m (2.6 ft.)) and aligned with the center of
the rear of the vehicle. Pay attention to the
direction of the key in the illustration on the left.
Check that when the key is brought within 0.7
to 1.0 m (2.3 to 3.3 ft.) of the vehicle, pressing
the back door opener switch opens the back
door.
(e) Check entry ignition function.
(1) With the key in your possession, check that
pressing the power switch will release the
steering wheel lock. Then, check that
depressing the brake pedal while pressing the
power switch starts the hybrid control system.
HINT:
The engine can be started only when the key
warning light is illuminated.
DL
DL–160
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
(2) With the key in your possession and the vehicle
stopped, check that pressing the power switch
stops the hybrid control system.
HINT:
The shift position must be P to be able to turn
the power switch from ON (ACC) to OFF.
Inspection
Point
B081012E01
DL
Center of
Vehicle
Inspection
Point
Luggage
Compartment
B081013E01
Rear of
Vehicle
10 cm or More
B080438E03
(f)
(3) Inspect the entry ignition operation's detection
area. Pay attention to the direction of the key in
the illustration on the left. When the key is in
either of the two locations in the illustration,
check that the engine can start.
NOTICE:
The engine cannot be started when the key
is on the instrument panel or package tray,
or in the glove box.
Check key lock-in prevention function.
(1) Place the key in the trunk. Check that: 1)
closing the back door triggers the key's
wireless buzzer (which lasts approximately 10
seconds), and 2) pressing the back door
opener switch opens the back door.
(2) Inspect the key lock-in prevention's detection
area. Pay attention to the direction of the key in
the illustration on the left. When the key is in
either of the two locations in the illustration,
check that: 1) closing the back door sounds the
key's wireless buzzer, and 2) pressing the back
door opener switch opens the back door.
NOTICE:
If the key in inside a metal briefcase, metal
box or any other metal storage item, the key
will not be able to be detected by the
system.
(3) Inspect the key lock-in prevention's detection
area and the trunk interior's door control
receiver for wave leaks. Hold the key at the
same height as the lower edge of the back door
and aligned with the center of the rear of the
vehicle. Pay attention to the direction and
position of the key in the illustration on the left.
Check that when the key is over 0.1 m (0.3 ft.)
from the vehicle's rear bumper, the key's
wireless buzzer does not sound.
HINT:
If the warning buzzer sounds, the trunk
interior's wireless door lock receiver may have
a wave leak.
(g) Check key cancel function.
(1) While the power switch is ON (IG), check that
the entry back door opener switch is the only
switch in the smart key system that can be
operated.
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
DL–161
(2) While the key cancel switch (smart key system
cancel switch) is ON, check that all switches in
the smart key system cannot be operated.
(h) Check key warning light function.
Condition
Indicator
Power switch is in ON (IG) mode and vehicle interior check is OK.
Illuminated
Power switch is in OFF mode and one of the doors is open.
Blinking
Power switch is in ON (ACC) / ON (IG) mode and all doors are locked.
Off
(i)
Smart Operation
Hazard Warning Light
HINT:
In cases where an illuminated condition and a
blinking condition are both satisfied, the indicator is
illuminated.
Check answer-back function (hazard warning light
flashing and buzzer sounding).
Buzzer
Entry Door Lock
Flashes once
Sounds once
Entry Door Unlock
Flashes twice
Sounds twice
Entry Back Door Open
Does not flash
Sounds once
DL
DL–162
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
Key Cancel Switch does not Operate
DESCRIPTION
When the key cancel switch is ON, all entry functions will stop operating. If the key cancel switch is not
turned ON but all entry functions stop operating, one of the following is malfunctioning: 1) key cancel
switch, 2) certification ECU, or 3) wire harness.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Certification ECU
DL
CNSL
Key Cancel Switch
B115339E06
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK WIRELESS DOOR LOCK OPERATION
(a) Check that the wireless door lock function operates
normally.
OK:
Wireless door lock function operates normally.
NG
OK
GO TO WIRELESS DOOR LOCK CONTROL
SYSTEM (w/ SMART KEY SYSTEM)
DL–163
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
2
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (KEY CANCEL SWITCH)
(a) Check the DATA LIST for proper functioning of the
certification ECU.
Certification ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
SMART CANCEL SW
Key cancel switch /
ON or OFF
ON: Key cancel switch is ON
OFF: Key cancel switch is OFF
-
OK:
OFF (key cancel switch is OFF) appears on the
screen.
OK
REPLACE CERTIFICATION ECU
NG
3
DL
INSPECT KEY CANCEL SWITCH
(a) Measure the resistance of the switch.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
Not pushed (OFF)
10 kΩ or higher
1-2
Pushed (ON)
Below 1 Ω
NG
B050965E01
OK
REPLACE KEY CANCEL SWITCH
DL–164
4
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (KEY CANCEL SWITCH - CERTIFICATION ECU AND BODY
GROUND)
(a) Disconnect S12 switch connector.
(b) Disconnect S11 ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
S12
Key Cancel Switch
S11
DL
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S12-1 - S11-25 (CNSL)
Below 1 Ω
S12-2 - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
S12-1 or S11-25 (CNSL) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
Certification ECU
CNSL
B079797E01
OK
REPLACE CERTIFICATION ECU
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
DL–165
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
Driver Side Door Entry Unlock Function does not Operate
DESCRIPTION
When an ID code from the door electrical key oscillator LH matches an ID code from the key, the
certification ECU outputs a SEL1 signal (Lo when output) to the door electrical key oscillator LH, activates
the touch sensor inside the outside door handle, and enters unlock standby condition. When the touch
sensor is touched, the electrical key oscillator LH sends a SENS signal (Lo when output) to the
certification ECU and the certification ECU sends an unlock signal to the driver door lock.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Electrical Key Antenna LH
(Driver Side)
Door Electrical Key Oscillator LH
(Driver Side)
ANT1
ANT1
ANT2
ANT2
SGT
Certification ECU
SEL
SEL1
SENS
SEN1
DL
GND
SGT
B128890E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK MANUAL DOOR UNLOCK OPERATION
(a) Check that the manual door unlock function operates
normally.
OK:
Manual door unlock function operates normally.
NG
OK
GO TO POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL
SYSTEM
DL–166
2
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
CHECK DOOR ELECTRICAL KEY OSCILLATOR LH (SEL VOLTAGE)
(a) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the
connector when the key is operated.
Standard voltage
GND
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
D16-2 (SEL) - D16-8
(GND)
Key at least 5 m (16.4
ft.) away from door
10 to 14 V
Key within 0.7 m (2.3 ft.)
from door
Below 1 V
SEL
B080049E02
NG
Go to step 7
OK
DL
3
CHECK DOOR ELECTRICAL KEY OSCILLATOR LH (SENS VOLTAGE)
(a) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the
connector when the outside door handle is touched.
Standard voltage
GND
Condition
Specified Condition
D16-3 (SENS) - D16-8
(GND)
Outside door handle
not touched
10 to 14 V
Outside door handle
touched
Below 1 V
SENS
B080049E03
NG
Tester Connection
OK
Go to step 5
DL–167
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (DOOR ELECTRICAL KEY OSCILLATOR LH - CERTIFICATION
ECU)
(a) Disconnect the D16 oscillator connector.
(b) Disconnect the S11 ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
S11
Certification ECU
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D16-3 (SENS) - S11-21 (SEN1)
Below 1 Ω
D16-3 (SENS) or S11-21 (SEN1) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
SEN1
NG
D16
Door Electrical Key Oscillator LH
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
DL
SENS
B079781E03
OK
5
CHECK OPERATION OF DOOR ELECTRICAL KEY OSCILLATOR LH
(a) After replacing the door electrical key oscillator on the
driver's side with a new one, check that the entry unlock
function operates normally.
OK:
Entry unlock function operates normally.
OK
NG
REPLACE DOOR ELECTRICAL KEY
OSCILLATOR LH
DL–168
6
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (DOOR ELECTRICAL KEY OSCILLATOR LH - ELECTRICAL KEY
ANTENNA)
Wire Harness Side
Door Electrical Key Oscillator LH
D16
GND
SGT
ANT1
ANT2
Electrical Key Antenna LH
DL
E8
ANT2
ANT1
SGT
(a) Disconnect the D16 oscillator connector.
(b) Disconnect the E8 antenna connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D16-6 (ANT1) - E8-5 (ANT1)
Below 1 Ω
D16-7 (ANT2) - E8-2 (ANT2)
Below 1 Ω
D16-5 (SGT) - E8-6 (SGT)
Below 1 Ω
D16-8 (GND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
D16-6 (ANT1) or E8-5 (ANT1) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
D16-7 (ANT2) or E8-2 (ANT2) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
D16-5 (SGT) or E8-6 (SGT) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
B079782E01
OK
REPLACE ELECTRICAL KEY ANTENNA LH
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
DL–169
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
7
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (DOOR ELECTRICAL KEY OSCILLATOR LH - CERTIFICATION
ECU)
(a) Disconnect the D16 oscillator connector.
(b) Disconnect the S11 ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
S11
Certification ECU
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D16-2 (SEL) - S11-23 (SEL1)
Below 1 Ω
D16-2 (SEL) or S11-23 (SEL1) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
SEL1
NG
D16
Door Electrical Key Oscillator LH
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
DL
SEL
B079781E04
OK
REPLACE CERTIFICATION ECU
DL–170
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
Front Passenger Side Door Entry Unlock Function does not Operate
DESCRIPTION
When an ID code from the door electrical key oscillator RH matches an ID code from the key, the
certification ECU outputs a SEL2 signal (Lo when output) to the door electrical key oscillator RH, activates
the touch sensor inside the outside door handle, and enters unlock standby condition. When the touch
sensor is touched, the door electrical key oscillator sends a SENS signal (Lo when output) to the
certification ECU and the certification ECU sends an unlock signal to each door lock.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Electrical Key Antenna RH
(Front Passenger Side)
Door Electrical Key Oscillator RH
(Front Passenger Side)
DL
ANT1
ANT1
ANT2
ANT2
SGT
Certification ECU
SEL
SEL2
SENS
SEN2
GND
SGT
B128890E03
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK MANUAL DOOR UNLOCK OPERATION
(a) Check that the manual door lock and unlock function
operates normally.
OK:
Manual door lock and unlock function operates
normally.
NG
OK
GO TO POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL
SYSTEM
DL–171
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
2
CHECK DOOR ELECTRICAL KEY OSCILLATOR RH (SEL VOLTAGE)
(a) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the
connector when the key is operated.
Standard voltage
GND
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
D17-2 (SEL) - D17-8
(GND)
Key at least 5 m (16.4
ft.) away from door
10 to 14 V
Key within 0.7 m (2.3 ft.)
from door
Below 1 V
SEL
B080049E02
NG
Go to step 7
OK
3
CHECK DOOR ELECTRICAL KEY OSCILLATOR RH (SENS VOLTAGE)
DL
(a) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the
connector when the outside door handle is touched.
Standard voltage
GND
Condition
Specified Condition
D17-3 (SENS) - D17-8
(GND)
Outside door handle
not touched
10 to 14 V
Outside door handle
touched
Below 1 V
SENS
B080049E03
NG
Tester Connection
OK
Go to step 5
DL–172
4
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (DOOR ELECTRICAL KEY OSCILLATOR RH - CERTIFICATION
ECU)
(a) Disconnect the D17 oscillator connector.
(b) Disconnect the S11 ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
S11
Certification ECU
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D17-3 (SENS) - S11-22 (SEN2)
Below 1 Ω
D17-3 (SENS) or S11-22 (SEN2) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
SEN2
NG
D17
Door Electrical Key Oscillator RH
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
DL
SENS
B079781E05
OK
5
CHECK OPERATION OF DOOR ELECTRICAL KEY OSCILLATOR RH
(a) After replacing the door electrical key oscillator on the
front passenger's side with a new one, check that the
entry unlock function operates normally.
OK:
Entry unlock function operates normally.
OK
NG
REPLACE DOOR ELECTRICAL KEY
OSCILLATOR RH
DL–173
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
6
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (DOOR ELECTRICAL KEY OSCILLATOR RH - ELECTRICAL KEY
ANTENNA)
Wire Harness Side
Door Electrical Key Oscillator RH
D17
GND
SGT
ANT1
ANT2
Electrical Key Antenna RH
E9
ANT2
ANT1
SGT
(a) Disconnect the D17 oscillator connector.
(b) Disconnect the E9 antenna connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D17-6 (ANT1) - E9-5 (ANT1)
Below 1 Ω
D17-7 (ANT2) - E9-2 (ANT2)
Below 1 Ω
D17-5 (SGT) - E9-6 (SGT)
Below 1 Ω
D17-8 (GND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
D17-6 (ANT1) or E9-5 (ANT1) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
D17-7 (ANT2) or E9-2 (ANT2) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
D17-5 (SGT) or E9-6 (SGT) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
B079782E02
OK
REPLACE ELECTRICAL KEY ANTENNA RH
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
DL
DL–174
7
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (DOOR ELECTRICAL KEY OSCILLATOR RH - CERTIFICATION
ECU)
(a) Disconnect the D17 oscillator connector.
(b) Disconnect the S11 ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
S11
Certification ECU
SEL2
DL
SEL
B079781E08
REPLACE CERTIFICATION ECU
Specified Condition
D17-2 (SEL) - S11-24 (SEL2)
Below 1 Ω
D17-2 (SEL) or S11-24 (SEL2) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
D17
Door Electrical Key Oscillator RH
OK
Tester Connection
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
DL–175
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
Driver Side Door Entry Lock and Unlock Functions do not Operate
DESCRIPTION
Both the entry lock and unlock functions do not operate when: 1) nothing is output from the door electrical
key oscillator LH, 2) the smart key system is disabled through customization, or 3) the entire power door
lock control system is malfunctioning.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Door Electrical Key Oscillator LH
from Battery
DOME
Certification ECU
+B
CLG1
CLG
DL
GND
B128889E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK MANUAL DOOR LOCK AND UNLOCK OPERATION
(a) Check that the manual door lock and unlock function
operates normally.
OK:
Manual door lock and unlock function operates
normally
NG
GO TO POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL
SYSTEM
OK
2
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (DOOR ELECTRICAL KEY
OSCILLATOR LH)
(a) Select the ACTIVE TEST, use the intelligent tester to
generate a control command, and then check that the
oscillator operates.
Certification ECU
Item
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
D TRANSMITTER
Driver side transmitter ON / OFF
-
OK:
When key is brought close to door oscillator that is
ON, indicator on key illuminates.
DL–176
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
OK
REPLACE CERTIFICATION ECU
NG
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (DOOR ELECTRICAL KEY OSCILLATOR LH - CERTIFICATION
ECU, BATTERY AND BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the D16 oscillator connector.
(b) Disconnect the S11 ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
S11
Certification ECU
CLG1
DL
D16
Door Electrical Key Oscillator LH
+B
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D16-4 (CLG) - S11-13 (CLG1)
Below 1 Ω
D16-4 (CLG) or S11-13 (CLG1) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
D16-8 (GND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
(d) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
GND
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D16-1 (+B) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
CLG
B079781E01
OK
4
CHECK DOOR ELECTRICAL KEY OSCILLATOR LH (CLG VOLTAGE)
(a) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the
connector when the power switch is operated.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
D16-4 (CLG) - Body
ground
Power switch OFF
Alternating between 5 V
and below 1 V
Power switch ON (IG)
Below 1 V
CLG
NG
B080049E01
OK
REPLACE CERTIFICATION ECU
REPLACE DOOR ELECTRICAL KEY
OSCILLATOR LH
DL–177
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
Front Passenger Side Door Entry Lock and Unlock Functions do not
Operate
DESCRIPTION
Both the entry lock and unlock functions do not operate when: 1) nothing is output from the door electrical
key oscillator RH, 2) the smart key system is disabled through customization, or 3) the entire power door
lock control system is malfunctioning.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Door Electrical Key Oscillator RH
from Battery
DOME
Certification ECU
+B
DL
CLG2
CLG
GND
B128889E02
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK MANUAL DOOR LOCK AND UNLOCK OPERATION
(a) Check that the manual door lock and unlock function
operates normally.
OK:
Manual door lock and unlock function operates
normally.
NG
GO TO POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL
SYSTEM
OK
2
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (DOOR ELECTRICAL KEY
OSCILLATOR RH)
(a) Select the ACTIVE TEST, use the intelligent tester to
generate a control command, and then check that the
oscillator operates.
Certification ECU
Item
Test Details
Diagnostic Notes
P TRANSMITTER
Front passenger side transmitter
ON / OFF
-
DL–178
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
OK:
When key is brought close to door oscillator that is
ON, indicator on key illuminates.
OK
REPLACE CERTIFICATION ECU
NG
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (DOOR ELECTRICAL KEY OSCILLATOR RH - CERTIFICATION
ECU, BATTERY AND BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the D17 oscillator connector.
(b) Disconnect the S11 ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
S11
Certification ECU
DL
CLG1
D17
Door Electrical Key Oscillator RH
+B
GND
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D17-4 (CLG) - S11-14 (CLG2)
Below 1 Ω
D17-4 (CLG) or S11-14 (CLG2) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
D17-8 (GND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
(d) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D17-1 (+B) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
CLG
B079781E02
OK
4
CHECK DOOR ELECTRICAL KEY OSCILLATOR RH (CLG VOLTAGE)
(a) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the
connector when the power switch is operated.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
D17-4 (CLG) - Body
ground
Power switch OFF
Alternating between 5 V
and below 1 V
Power switch ON (IG)
Below 1 V
CLG
NG
B080049E01
OK
REPLACE CERTIFICATION ECU
REPLACE DOOR ELECTRICAL KEY
OSCILLATOR RH
DL–179
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
Driver Side Door Entry Lock Function does not Operate
DESCRIPTION
When the touch sensor inside the outside door handle LH is touched, the certification ECU sends a
request signal to the door electrical key oscillator LH. The key receives this request and transmits its ID
code. Upon receiving the ID code, the certification ECU determines that the key is outside the vehicle and
sends a lock signal to the driver door lock through the instrument panel junction block (multiplex network
body ECU).
WIRING DIAGRAM
Certification ECU
Electrical Key Antenna LH
TRG+
DL
TSW1
TRG-
B128891E03
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK MANUAL DOOR LOCK OPERATION
(a) Check that the manual door lock function operates
normally.
OK:
Manual door lock function operates normally.
NG
OK
GO TO POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL
SYSTEM
DL–180
2
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (LOCK SWITCH)
(a) Check the DATA LIST for proper functioning of the
certification ECU.
Certification ECU
Item
Measure Item / Range (Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
D TRIGGER SW
D-door trigger switch /
ON or OFF
ON: Lock switch is pushed
OFF: Lock switch is not pushed
-
OK:
ON (lock switch is pushed) appears on the screen.
OK
REPLACE CERTIFICATION ECU
NG
DL
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ELECTRICAL KEY ANTENNA LH - CERTIFICATION ECU AND
BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect E8 antenna connector.
(b) Disconnect S11 ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Electrical Key Antenna LH
E8
Tester Connection
TRGTRG+
S11
TSW1
B080378E01
OK
E8-3 (TRG+) - S11-5 (TSW1)
Below 1 Ω
E8-1 (TRG-) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
E8-3 (TRG+) or S11-5 (TSW1) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
Certification ECU
Specified Condition
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
DL–181
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
4
INSPECT ELECTRICAL KEY ANTENNA LH
(a) Measure the resistance of the outside door handle.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
TRG-
TRG+
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
1 (TRG-) - 3 (TRG+)
Switch pushed
Below 1 Ω
1 (TRG-) - 3 (TRG+)
Switch not pushed
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPLACE ELECTRICAL KEY ANTENNA LH
E067622E02
OK
REPLACE CERTIFICATION ECU
DL
DL–182
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
Front Passenger Side Door Entry Lock Function does not Operate
DESCRIPTION
When the touch sensor inside the outside door handle RH is touched, the certification ECU sends a
request signal to the door electrical key oscillator. The key receives this request and transmits its ID code.
Upon receiving the ID code, the certification ECU determines that the key is outside the vehicle and sends
a lock signal to the passenger door lock through the instrument panel junction block (multiplex network
body ECU).
WIRING DIAGRAM
Electrical Key Antenna RH
DL
Certification ECU
TSW2
TRG+
TRG-
B128891E02
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK MANUAL DOOR LOCK OPERATION
(a) Check that the manual door lock function operates
normally.
OK:
Manual door lock function operates normally.
NG
OK
GO TO POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL
SYSTEM
DL–183
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
2
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (LOCK SWITCH)
(a) Check the DATA LIST for proper functioning of the
certification ECU.
Certification ECU
Item Normal
Condition
Diagnostic
Note
P TRIGGER SW
P-door trigger switch /
ON or OFF
ON: Lock switch is pushed
OFF: Lock switch is not pushed
-
OK:
ON (lock switch is pushed) appears on the screen.
OK
REPLACE CERTIFICATION ECU
NG
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ELECTRICAL KEY ANTENNA RH - CERTIFICATION ECU AND
BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the E9 antenna connector.
(b) Disconnect the S11 ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Electrical Key Antenna RH
E9
Tester Connection
TRGTRG+
S11
TSW2
B080378E02
OK
E9-3 (TRG+) - S11-6 (TSW2)
Below 1 Ω
E9-1 (TRG-) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
E9-3 (TRG+) or S11-6 (TSW2) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
Certification ECU
Specified Condition
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
DL
DL–184
4
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
INSPECT ELECTRICAL KEY ANTENNA RH
(a) Measure the resistance of the outside door handle.
Standard resistance
TRG-
TRG+
DL
REPLACE CERTIFICATION ECU
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
1 (TRG-) - 3 (TRG+)
Switch pushed
Below 1 Ω
1 (TRG-) - 3 (TRG+)
Switch not pushed
10 kΩ or higher
NG
E067622E02
OK
Tester Connection
REPLACE ELECTRICAL KEY ANTENNA RH
DL–185
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
Key Luggage Compartment Lock-in Prevention Function does not
Operate
DESCRIPTION
With the key inside the luggage compartment, press the back door opener switch. The certification ECU
uses the back door oscillators (outer and inner) to output a request signal. The back door outer oscillator
cannot verify an ID code in this situation. The key receives the request and transmits its ID code to the
antenna. The ID code is then sent to the certification ECU through the back door inner oscillator in order
to be confirmed by the certification ECU. If the ID code is verified, the certification ECU sends a back door
open signal to the driver side junction block (main body ECU) using the multiplex communication line and
stops outputting request signals. The back door then can be opened.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Luggage Electrical Key Oscillator
(Inner)
from Battery
DOME
Certification ECU
+B
CLG
CLG7
GND
B128889E04
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK BACK DOOR ENTRY UNLOCK FUNCTION OPERATES
(a) Check that the back door entry unlock function operates
normally.
OK:
Back door entry unlock function operates
normally.
NG
OK
GO TO PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
DL
DL–186
2
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (LUGGAGE ELECTRICAL KEY OSCILLATOR (INNER) BATTERY AND BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the L6 connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
L6
Specified Condition
L6-1 (+B) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
1 2 3 4 5
+B
Tester Connection
GND
B106249E01
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
L6-5 (GND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
DL
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
3
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (LUGGAGE ELECTRICAL KEY
OSCILLATOR (INNER))
(a) Select the ACTIVE TEST, use the intelligent tester to
generate a control command, and then check that the
oscillator (inner) operates.
Certification ECU
Item
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
IN BDR TRNSMITTR
Back door inner transmitter
ON / OFF
-
OK:
ON (key is in luggage room) appears on the screen.
NG
OK
REPLACE LUGGAGE ELECTRICAL KEY
OSCILLATOR (INNER)
DL–187
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (CERTIFICATION ECU - LUGGAGE ELECTRICAL KEY
OSCILLATOR (INNER))
(a) Disconnect the S11 ECU connector.
(b) Disconnect the L6 oscillator connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Luggage Electrical Key Oscillator
(Inner)
L6
CLG
S11
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S11-38 (CLG7) - L6-3 (CLG)
Below 1 Ω
S11-38 (CLG7) or L6-3 (CLG) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
Certification ECU
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
DL
CLG7
B079793E04
OK
REPLACE CERTIFICATION ECU
DL–188
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
Key Warning Light does not Come ON
DESCRIPTION
The certification ECU and combination meter communicate through the multiplex communication line
(BEAN line). When the combination meter's key warning light does not illuminate / flash as specified (see
page DL-155), one of the following is malfunctioning: 1) multiplex communication system, 2) certification
ECU, or 3) combination meter.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Combination Meter
(Meter ECU)
DL
Certification ECU
MPX-
BEAN line
MPX1
MPX+
BEAN line
MPX2
B128888E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
(a) Check that the multiplex communication system
operates normally.
OK:
Multiplex communication system operates
normally.
NG
GO TO MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION
SYSTEM
OK
2
CHECK OPERATION OF COMBINATION METER
(a) After replacing the combination meter with a new one,
check that the key warning light operates normally.
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
DL–189
OK:
Key warning light operates normally
NG
REPLACE CERTIFICATION ECU
OK
END
DL
DL–190
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
Entry Functions do not Operate at All
DESCRIPTION
When the entry functions do not operate at all, it is possible that the certification ECU is malfunctioning or
that the wire harness leading to the certification ECU is short-circuited.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Certification ECU
IG1
ECU-IG
DL
Converter
IG
from Battery
AND
Power Source Control ECU
S
P/I
AM2
ACC
IG1D
AM1
ACCD
to ACC Fuse
DC/DC-S
DOME
+B1
E
MAIN
B140128E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT FUSE (DOME)
(a) Remove the DOME fuse from the engine room junction
block and relay block.
DL–191
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
(b) Measure the resistance of the fuses.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE FUSE
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (CERTIFICATION ECU- BATTERY AND BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the S11 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
S11
Certification ECU
+B1
E
IG
B079785E01
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
S11-18 (IG) - Body
ground
Power switch OFF
Below 1 V
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
S11-1 (+B1) - Body
ground
Always
10 to 14 V
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S11-17 (E) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
OK
REPLACE CERTIFICATION ECU
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
DL
DL–192
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
Vehicle is not Ready to Start when Driver Has Key
DESCRIPTION
If the entry ignition function does not operate, insert the key into the key slot and check if the hybrid
control system starts. If the hybrid control system starts (the transponder key ECU outputs a start
permission to the hybrid control system and the hybrid control system starts), it can be assumed that only
the entry ignition system is malfunctioning.
The certification ECU uses the indoor electrical key oscillator to send a request signal to the key when: 1)
the driver's door is opened and closed, or 2) the power switch is changed from ON (ACC) to OFF or OFF
to ON. Then, the key transmits its ID code to the door control receiver. The ID code, which is then sent to
the certification ECU, is verified by the certification ECU and the verification result is sent to the
transponder key ECU.
The transponder key ECU and the certification ECU communicate encryption codes to each other using
the multiplex communication line. When the return code from the certification ECU matches the ID code in
memory, the transponder key ECU sends a hybrid control system start permission signal to the hybrid
control ECU. Pressing the power switch while depressing the brake pedal then starts the hybrid control
system. With the vehicle stopped, pressing the power switch again stops the hybrid control system.
DL
WIRING DIAGRAM
Indoor Electrical Key Oscillator
from Battery
DOME
Certification ECU
+B
CLG3
CLG5
GND
B128889E06
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK ENTRY DOOR LOCK AND UN LOCK OPERATION
(a) Check that the entry lock and unlock functions operate
normally.
OK:
Entry lock and unlock functions operate normally
NG
OK
GO TO PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
DL–193
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
2
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (HALFWAY SWITCH)
(a) Check the DATA LIST for proper functioning of the
halfway switch.
Certification ECU
Item
Measurement Item /
Range (Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
KEY UNLK WRN SW
Key unlock warning switch /
ON or OFF
OK: Key is in key slot
OFF: No key is in key slot
-
OK:
ON (key is in key slot) appears on screen.
NG
GO TO SMART KEY SYSTEM (for starting)
OK
3
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (INDOOR ELECTRICAL KEY
OSCILLATOR)
(a) Select the ACTIVE TEST, use the intelligent tester to
generate a control command, and then check that the
oscillator operates.
Certification ECU
Item
Tester Details
Diagnostic Note
FR TRANSMITTER
Indoor electrical key oscillator (front)
ON / OFF
-
OK:
When key is brought close to indoor electrical key
oscillator, oscillator is turned ON and indicator on
key illuminates.
OK
REPLACE CERTIFICATION ECU
NG
4
INSPECT FUSE (MPX-B, D/C CUT)
(a) Remove the MPX-B and D/C CUT fuses from the engine
room relay block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the fuses.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
OK
REPLACE FUSE
DL
DL–194
5
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (INDOOR ELECTRICAL KEY OSCILLATOR - BATTERY AND
BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the R8 oscillator connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
R8
Specified Condition
R8-1 (+B) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
1 2 3 4 5
+B
Tester Connection
GND
B106249E02
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
R8-5 (GND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
DL
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
6
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (INDOOR ELECTRICAL KEY OSCILLATOR - CERTIFICATION
ECU)
(a) Disconnect the R8 oscillator connectors.
(b) Disconnect the S11 ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Indoor Electrical Key Oscillator
R8
CLG3
S11
Specified Condition
R8-3 (CLG3) - S11-36 (CLG5)
Below 1 Ω
R8-3 (CLG3) or S11-36 (CLG5) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
Certification ECU
CLG5
B079793E03
OK
Tester Connection
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
DL–195
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
7
CHECK INDOOR ELECTRICAL KEY OSCILLATOR (CLG3 VOLTAGE)
(a) Measure the voltage of the oscillator connector.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
R8-3 (CLG3) - R8-5
(GND)
During Active Test
Alternating between 5 V
and below 1 V
NG
GND
CLG3
REPLACE INDOOR ELECTRICAL KEY
OSCILLATOR
B080048E05
OK
REPLACE CERTIFICATION ECU
DL
DL–196
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
Back Door Entry Unlock Function does not Operate
DESCRIPTION
When the back door opener switch is turned ON, the certification ECU uses the back door oscillator
(outer) and antenna to output a request signal to the outside of the vehicle for a distance of approximately
1.0 m (3.3 ft.) from the back door. A key near the back door detects this request and transmits its ID code.
The door control receiver receives the ID code and sends this ID code to the certification ECU. The
certification ECU checks if the ID code is valid. If the ID code is verified, the certification ECU sends a
back door open signal to the driver side junction block (main body ECU) using the multiplex
communication line and stops outputting request signals. The driver side junction block (main body ECU)
then unlocks the back door.
WIRING DIAGRAM
DL
Electrical Key Antenna
(Luggage)
Luggage Electrical Key Oscillator
(Outer)
+B
ANT1
ANT1
ANT2
ANT2
Certification ECU
DOME
from
Battery
CLG3
CLG8
GND
Back Door Lock Switch
TSW6
B128892E02
DL–197
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK ENTRY LOCK AND UNLOCK OPERATION
(a) Check that the entry lock and unlock functions operate
normally.
OK:
Entry lock and unlock functions operate normally.
NG
GO TO PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
OK
2
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (BACK DOOR LOCK SWITCH)
(a) Check the DATA LIST for proper functioning of the back
door lock switch.
Certification ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
TR / B-DOOR LOCK
Trunk / Back-door lock switch /
ON or OFF
ON: Back door lock switch is
pushed
OFF: Back door lock switch is not
pushed
-
OK:
ON (back door lock switch is pushed) appears on
the screen.
OK
Go to step 5
NG
3
INSPECT BACK DOOR OPENER SWITCH
(a) Disconnect the L4 switch connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the switch.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
Not pushed (OFF)
10 kΩ or higher
1-2
Pushed (ON)
Below 1 Ω
NG
B079788E01
OK
REPLACE BACK DOOR LOCK
DL
DL–198
4
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (CERTIFICATION ECU - BACK DOOR LOCK SWITCH AND BODY
GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the S11 ECU connector.
(b) Disconnect the L4 switch connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Certification ECU
S11
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S11-8 (TSW6) - L4-3
Below 1 Ω
L4-4 - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
TSW6
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
Back Door Lock Switch
DL
L4
B079789E01
OK
REPLACE CERTIFICATION ECU
5
INSPECT ELECTRICAL KEY ANTENNA (LUGGAGE)
(a) Measure the resistance of antenna.
Standard resistance
ANT1
Condition
Specified Condition
1 (ANT2) - 2 (ANT1)
Back door lock switch
pushed
Below 1 Ω
Back door lock switch
not pushed
10 kΩ or higher
NG
ANT2
B050965E02
OK
Tester Connection
REPLACE ELECTRICAL KEY ANTENNA
(LUGGAGE)
DL–199
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
6
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (LUGGAGE ELECTRICAL KEY OSCILLATOR (OUTER) ELECTRICAL KEY ANTENNA (LUGGAGE))
Wire Harness Side
Luggage Electrical Key Oscillator (Outer)
L7
ANT1
(a) Disconnect the L7 oscillator connector.
(b) Disconnect the E10 antenna connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
L7-6 (ANT1) - E10-2 (ANT1)
Below 1 Ω
L7-7 (ANT2) - E10-1 (ANT2)
Below 1 Ω
NG
ANT2
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
Electrical Key Antenna (Luggage)
DL
E10
ANT1
ANT2
B079791E02
OK
7
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (LUGGAGE ELECTRICAL KEY OSCILLATOR (OUTER) - BODY
GROUND)
Wire Harness Side
Luggage Electrical Key Oscillator (Outer)
L7
+B
GND
B079780E01
(a) Disconnect the L7 oscillator connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
L7-1 (+B) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
L7-8 (GND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
DL–200
8
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (LUGGAGE ELECTRICAL KEY
OSCILLATOR (OUTER))
(a) Select the ACTIVE TEST, use the intelligent tester to
generate a control command, and then check that the
oscillator (outer) operates.
Certification ECU
Item
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
BDOOR TRNSMTTR
Back door outer transmitter
ON / OFF
-
OK:
When key is brought close to luggage
compartment door, oscillator (outer) is turned ON
and indicator on key illuminates.
OK
DL
REPLACE CERTIFICATION ECU
NG
9
CHECK LUGGAGE ELECTRICAL KEY OSCILLATOR (OUTER) (CLG VOLTAGE)
(a) Remove the oscillator but do not disconnect its
connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the connector.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
L7-4 (CLG) - Body
ground
Back door lock switch
OFF
Below 1 V
Back door lock switch
ON
Alternating between 5 V
and below 1 V
CLG
B080049E01
NG
OK
REPLACE LUGGAGE ELECTRICAL KEY
OSCILLATOR (OUTER)
DL–201
DOOR LOCK – SMART KEY SYSTEM
10
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (CERTIFICATION ECU- LUGGAGE ELECTRICAL KEY
OSCILLATOR (OUTER))
(a) Disconnect the S11 ECU connector.
(b) Disconnect the L7 oscillator connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Certification ECU
S11
CLG8
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S11-39 (CLG8) - L7-4 (CLG)
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
Luggage Electrical Key Oscillator (Outer)
DL
L7
CLG
B079781E07
OK
REPLACE CERTIFICATION ECU
DOOR LOCK – KEY REMINDER WARNING SYSTEM
DL–199
KEY REMINDER WARNING
SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
NOTICE FOR INITIALIZATION:
When disconnecting the negative (-) battery terminal,
initialize the following system(s) after the terminal is
reconnected.
System Name
See procedure
Power Window Control System
IN-32
NOTICES FOR HYBRID SYSTEM ACTIVATION:
When the warning light is illuminated or the battery has
been disconnected and reconnected, pressing the
power switch may not start the system on the first try. If
so, press the power switch again.
DL
DL–200
DOOR LOCK – KEY REMINDER WARNING SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
COMBINATION METER
- BUZZER
KEY SLOT
- HALFWAY SWITCH
FRONT DOOR COURTESY
LIGHT SWITCH LH
TRANSPONDER KEY ECU
DL
DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
- BODY ECU
E122760E04
DOOR LOCK – KEY REMINDER WARNING SYSTEM
DL–201
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
Front Door Courtesy
Light Switch LH
Driver Side Junction Block
- Body ECU
DL
BEAN
Key Slot
- Halfway Switch
BEAN
Transponder Key
ECU
Combination Meter
- Buzzer
E129441E01
DL–202
DOOR LOCK – KEY REMINDER WARNING SYSTEM
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
2.
DL
KEY REMINDER WARNING SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
(a) The key reminder warning system sounds the
combination meter buzzer as a warning when the
following occur simultaneously: 1) the power switch
is set to OFF or ON (ACC), 2) the key is inserted
into the key slot, and 3) the driver side door is
opened.
FUNCTION OF COMPONENT
Components
Function
Front door courtesy light switch LH
Detects if driver side door is open or closed and outputs data to
multiplex network body ECU.
Key slot (Halfway switch)
Detects if key is / is not in key slot and outputs data to transponder key
ECU.
Combination meter
Receives buzzer request signal from transponder key ECU (after
transponder key ECU receives halfway switch signal and front door
courtesy light switch LH signal). Then combination meter actuates
driver circuit to sound built-in multi-buzzer intermittently.
3.
FUNCTION OF DESCRIPTION
(a) The key slot transmits a halfway switch status signal
to the transponder key ECU. The front door
courtesy light switch LH transmits a driver side door
courtesy switch status signal to the multiplex
network body ECU. With the power switch OFF or
ON (ACC), 2 conditions are required to activate the
key reminder warning system: 1) the transponder
key ECU receives a signal indicating that the key is
in the key slot, and 2) the transponder key ECU
receives a driver side door open signal via the
multiplex network body ECU. If both conditions are
satisfied, a buzzer request signal is transmitted from
the transponder key ECU to the combination meter
assembly via the BEAN. The combination meter
assembly then actuates the driver circuit to sound a
built-in multi-buzzer intermittently.
DOOR LOCK – KEY REMINDER WARNING SYSTEM
DL–203
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
• Use this procedure to troubleshoot the key reminder
warning system.
• *: Use the intelligent tester.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
INSPECT BATTERY VOLTAGE
Standard voltage:
11 to 14 V
If the voltage is below 11 V, recharge or replace the battery
before proceeding.
NEXT
3
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Result
Result
proceed to
DTC is not output
A
DTC is output
B
B
Go to step 5
A
4
OVERALL ANALYSIS AND TROUBLESHOOTING*
(a) Operation check (see page DL-203).
(b) Terminals of ECU (see page DL-205).
(c) DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST (see page DL-207).
NEXT
5
NEXT
ADJUST, REPAIR OR REPLACE
DL
DL–204
6
NEXT
END
DL
DOOR LOCK – KEY REMINDER WARNING SYSTEM
CONFIRMATION TEST
DOOR LOCK – KEY REMINDER WARNING SYSTEM
DL–205
OPERATION CHECK
1.
CHECK FUNCTION
(a) Check the key reminder warning buzzer sound
function.
(1) Close the driver side door, insert the key into the
key slot and turn the power switch OFF.
(2) Open the driver side door. Check that the key
reminder warning buzzer sounds intermittently.
(b) Check that the key reminder warning buzzer stops.
(1) While the buzzer is sounding, perform one of the
following operations:
• Close the driver side door (front door
courtesy light switch LH is turned OFF).
• Turn the power switch ON (IG).
• Pull out the key from the key slot.
(2) Check that the key reminder warning buzzer
stops sounding.
DL
DL–206
DOOR LOCK – KEY REMINDER WARNING SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
Use the table below to help determine the cause of the
problem symptom. The potential causes of the symptoms are
listed in order of probability in the "Suspected area" column of
the table. Check each symptom by checking the suspected
areas in the order they are listed. Replace parts as
necessary.
Key reminder warning system
Symptom
Key reminder buzzer does not sound
DL
Suspected area
See page
1. Front door courtesy light switch circuit (driver side)
DL-209
2. Combination meter
DL-209
3. Power source circuit
DL-209
4. Key slot
DL-209
5. Wire harness
DL-209
6. Transponder key ECU
DL-209
DL–207
DOOR LOCK – KEY REMINDER WARNING SYSTEM
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
CHECK DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
Vehicle Front Side
Vehicle Rear Side
1D
1A
1E
1B
DL
Body ECU
1D
1A
1B
1E
E122744E02
(a) Disconnect the 1A, 1B, 1D and 1E junction block
connectors.
DL–208
DOOR LOCK – KEY REMINDER WARNING SYSTEM
(b) Measure the resistance and voltage of the wire
harness side connectors.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
ECUB (1A-30) - Body
ground
R - Body ground
+B power supply
Always
10 to 14 V
SIG (1B-1) - Body ground
W - Body ground
Ignition power supply
Power switch OFF
10 kΩ or higher
Power switch ON (IG)
Below 1 Ω
GND (1E-17) - Body
ground
W - B Body ground
Ground
Ground
Below 1 kΩ
KSW (1E-26) - Body
ground
Y - Body ground
Halfway switch input
No key in key slot
10 kΩ or higher
Key in key slot
Below 1 Ω
DTCY (1D-21) - Body
ground
V - Body ground
Door courtesy switch input
Driver side door CLOSED
10 kΩ or higher
Driver side door OPEN
Below 1 Ω
2.
DL
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
CHECK TRANSPONDER KEY ECU
T5
E122745E01
(a) Disconnect the T5 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the voltage and resistance of the wire
harness side connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
CPUB (T5-3) - Body
ground
L - Body ground
IG power supply
Always
10 to 14 V
ACC (T5-12) -Body
ground
P - Body ground
ACC power supply
Power switch OFF
10 to 14 V
Power switch ON (ACC)
0V
GND (T5-22) - Body
ground
W-B -Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
CUWS (T5-5) - Body
ground
B - Body ground
Halfway switch input
No key in key slot
10 kΩ or higher
Key in key slot
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
DL–209
DOOR LOCK – KEY REMINDER WARNING SYSTEM
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
CG
SG
SIL
1.
DESCRIPTION
Key reminder warning system data can be read in the
Data Link Connector 3 (DLC3) of the vehicle. When the
system seems to be malfunctioning, use the intelligent
tester to check for malfunctions and perform repairs.
2.
CHECK DLC3
The vehicle's ECU uses the ISO 15765-4 communication
protocol. The terminal arrangement of the DLC3
complies with SAE J1962 and matches the ISO 15765-4
format.
BAT
H100769E72
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
SIL (7) - SG (5)
Bus "+" line
During transmission
Pulse generation
CG (4) - Body ground
Chassis ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
SG (5) - Body ground
Signal ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
BAT (16) - Body ground
Battery positive
Always
11 to 14 V
Intelligent Tester
DLC3
CAN VIM
A082795E06
If the result is not as specified, the DLC3 may have a
malfunction. Repair or replace the harness and connector.
HINT:
• Connect the cable of the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM)
to the DLC3, turn the power switch ON (IG) and attempt to
use the tester.
• If the screen displays the message UNABLE TO
CONNECT TO VEHICLE, there is a problem either with
the vehicle or with the tester.
• If communication is normal when the intelligent tester is
connected to another vehicle, inspect the DLC3 on the
original vehicle.
• If communication is still not possible when the tester is
connected to another vehicle, the problem is probably in
the tester itself. Consult the Service Department listed in
the tester's instruction manual.
DL
DL–210
DOOR LOCK – KEY REMINDER WARNING SYSTEM
DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST
1.
READ DATA LIST
HINT:
Using the intelligent tester's DATA LIST allows switch,
actuator and other item values to be read without
removing any parts. Reading the DATA LIST early in
troubleshooting is one way to save time.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIN) to the
DCL3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Read the DATA LIST according to the display on the
tester.
Transponder key ECU
DL
Item
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
KEY UNLK WRN SW
Halfway switch signal/ON or OFF
ON: Key is in key slot.
OFF: No key is in key slot.
-
Iltem
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
D DOR CTY SW
Driver side door courtesy switch
signal / ON or OFF
ON: Driver side door is open.
OFF: Driver side door is closed.
-
Body ECU
DOOR LOCK – KEY REMINDER WARNING SYSTEM
DL–211
Key Reminder Buzzer does not Sound
DESCRIPTION
With the power switch OFF or ON (ACC), the combination meter sounds the buzzer when it receives a
buzzer request signal from the transponder key ECU using the BEAN. The transponder key ECU outputs
this signal when it receives: 1) a halfway switch signal (set when the key is in the key slot); and 2) a driver
side door courtesy switch signal from the multiplex network body ECU (set when the driver side door is
open).
DL
DL–212
DOOR LOCK – KEY REMINDER WARNING SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Transponder Key ECU
Key Slot
CUWS
MPX1
Combination Meter
Buzzer
MPX+
MPX2
GND
DL
Body ECU
MPX2
Front Door Courtesy Light Switch LH
DCTY
GND
E129445E01
DL–213
DOOR LOCK – KEY REMINDER WARNING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (DRIVER SIDE DOOR COURTESY LIGHT
SWITCH)
(a) Check the DATA LIST for proper functioning of the driver
side door courtesy switch.
Body ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
D DOR CTY SW
Driver side door courtesy switch
signal / ON or OFF
ON: Driver side door is open
OFF: Driver side door is closed
-
OK:
Tester display changes correctly according to
open / closed condition of door.
NG
Go to step 4
DL
OK
2
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (HALFWAY SWITCH)
(a) Check the DATA LIST for proper functioning of the key
slot.
Transponder key ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
KEY UNLK WRN SW
Halfway switch signal / ON or
OFF
ON: Key is in key slot
OFF: No key is in key slot
-
OK:
ON (key is in key slot) appears on the screen.
NG
Go to step 6
OK
3
CHECK COMBINATION METER
(a) Check the warning buzzer built into the combination
meter (see page ME-11).
OK:
Warning buzzer sounds.
NG
REPLACE COMBINATION METER
ASSEMBLY
OK
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK (BODY ECU)
DL–214
4
DOOR LOCK – KEY REMINDER WARNING SYSTEM
INSPECT FRONT DOOR COURTESY LIGHT SWITCH LH
(a) Remove the courtesy light switch.
(b) Measure the resistance of the switch.
Standard resistance
Not Pushed (ON)
Pushed (OFF)
Tester Condition
Switch Condition
Switch Condition
1 - Body ground
Not pushed
Below 1 Ω
1 - Body ground
Pushed
10 kΩ or higher
NG
Body Ground
E114552E08
REPLACE FRONT DOOR COURTESY LIGHT
SWITCH LH
OK
DL
5
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (COURTESY LIGHT SWITCH - BODY ECU)
(a) Disconnect the D7 switch connector.
(b) Disconnect the 1D junction block connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
D7
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D7-1 - 1D-21 (DCTY)
Below 1 Ω
NG
Front Door Courtesy
Light Switch LH
1D
Driver Side Junction Block
(Body ECU)
B079560E03
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
DL–215
DOOR LOCK – KEY REMINDER WARNING SYSTEM
OK
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK (BODY ECU)
6
INSPECT KEY SLOT
(a) Remove the key slot.
(b) Measure the resistance of the switch.
Standard resistance
KSW1
Tester Condition
Condition
2 (COM) - 4 (KSW1)
Key in key slot
Below 1 Ω
No key in key slot
10 kΩ or higher
NG
COM
Specified Condition
REPLACE KEY SLOT
DL
B079242E04
OK
7
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (KEY SLOT - INSTRUMENT TRANSPONDER KEY ECU)
(a) Disconnect the K2 key slot connector.
(b) Disconnect the T5 ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Key Slot
K2
COM
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
K2-4 (KSW1) - T5-5 (CUWS)
Below 1 Ω
K2-2 (COM) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
KSW1
NG
Transponder Key ECU
T5
CUWS
B080183E05
OK
REPLACE TRANSPONDER KEY ECU
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
DL–214
DOOR LOCK – TRANSMITTER BATTERY
TRANSMITTER BATTERY
BODY ELECTRICAL
DOOR
LOCK
COMPONENTS
TRANSMITTER BATTERY
COVER
SLIDE COVER
DL
TRANSMITTER BATTERY
(LITHIUM BATTERY:
CR1632)
TRANSMITTER HOUSING CASE
EMERGENCY KEY
B135694E01
DOOR LOCK – TRANSMITTER BATTERY
DL–215
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE TRANSMITTER BATTERY
NOTICE:
Take extra care when handing these precision
electronic components.
(a) Push and hold the release knob in the direction
indicated by the arrow in the illustration. Take the
emergency key out of the case.
Release
Knob
Emergency
Key
B080552E02
B
Side Cover
Release
Knob
(b) Push and hold the release knob in the direction
indicated by the arrow labeled A. Push out the side
cover in the direction indicated by the arrow labeled
B and remove the side cover.
A
B080553E01
(c) Remove the 4 screws and cover, as shown in the
illustration.
B073695E01
B073696E01
(d) Remove the transmitter's battery (lithium battery:
CR1632) from the transmitter, as shown in the
illustration.
NOTICE:
• Do not push the terminals with your finger.
• Do not forcibly pry up the battery. The
terminals may become damaged.
• Do not touch the battery with wet hands.
Water may cause rust.
• Do not touch or move any components inside
the transmitter, as it may cease to work.
DL
DL–216
DOOR LOCK – TRANSMITTER BATTERY
INSTALLATION
1.
O-Ring
Terminal
B079392E01
DL
Release
Knob
B
Slide Cover
INSTALL TRANSMITTER BATTERY
NOTICE:
Take care when handing these precision electronic
components.
(a) Install a new battery (lithium battery: CR1632) with
the positive (+) side up, as shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
• Be sure that the positive (+) side and the
negative (-) side of the transmitter battery are
matched up correctly.
• Be careful not to bend the transmitter battery
electrode during insertion.
• Keep the transmitter case interior free of dust
and oil.
(b) Check that the O-ring is not distorted or slipped off,
and install the cover.
(c) Install the 4 screws.
NOTICE:
Incomplete installation of the cover will cause
defective contact between the battery and
terminal.
(d) Push and hold the release knob in the direction
indicated by the arrow labeled A. Push in the slide
cover in the direction indicated by the arrow labeled
B and install the slide cover.
A
B080554E01
(e) Push and hold the release knob in the direction
indicated by the arrow. Insert the emergency key
into the case.
HINT:
After installation, press any of the transmitter's
switches. Check that the LED illuminates.
Release
Knob
Emergency
Key
B080555E01
DOOR LOCK – DOOR CONTROL TRANSMITTER
DL–217
DOOR CONTROL TRANSMITTER
INSPECTION
1.
B074738E01
INSPECT DOOR CONTROL TRANSMITTER
(a) Inspect operation of the transmitter.
(1) Remove the battery (lithium battery: CR1632)
from the transmitter (see page DL-215).
(2) Install a new or non-depleted battery.
HINT:
When a new or non-depleted transmitter
battery is not available, connect 2 new 1.5 V
batteries in series. Then connect leads to the
batteries and use the leads to apply voltage of
3 V to the transmitter, as shown in the
illumination.
(3) From outside the vehicle, approximately 1 m
(3.28 ft.) from the driver the outside door
handle, test the transmitter by pointing
transmitter at the vehicle and pressing a
transmitter switch.
OK:
Door lock can be operated via transmitter.
HINT:
• The operating range differs depending on
the user, the way the transmitter is held and
the location.
• Since the transmitter uses faint electric
waves, the operating range might be
shortened if noise or strong electric waves
occur in the area where the transmitter is
used. Or, the transmitter may not function.
(b) Install the battery (see page DL-216).
(c) Inspect the battery capacity.
HINT:
• When checking the amount of energy left in the
battery, the battery must be checked while it is
installed in the transmitter (a resistance of 1.2 kΩ
is applied to the battery). When the battery
energy is checked by itself (uninstalled), the
voltage reading will be more than 2.5 V until the
energy is depleted.
• If the transmitter is malfunctioning, the voltage
reading of the energy left in the battery may be
inaccurate.
(1) Remove the battery from the transmitter.
DL
DL–218
DOOR LOCK – DOOR CONTROL TRANSMITTER
(2) Connect a wire to the negative (-) terminal of
the transmitter and install the battery.
Wire
B074739E01
DL
B074740E01
(3) Connect the tester's positive (+) lead to the
battery's positive (+) terminal and the negative
(-) lead to the wire.
(4) Press one of the transmitter switches for
approximately 1 second.
(5) Press the transmitter switch again and check
the voltage.
Standard voltage:
2.2 V or higher
HINT:
• When the temperature of the battery is low,
the inspection cannot be made correctly.
When the outcome of the test is less than
2.2 V, conduct the test again after leaving
the battery in a place with a temperature
18°C (64°F) for more than 30 minutes.
• Read the voltage immediately after the
switch is pressed. When 0.8 seconds have
pressed after the switch is pressed, the
automatic power-off function starts and
resistance applied to the battery will cease.
The voltage of the battery will be 2.5 V or
more.
• Press the switch at least 3 times before
reading the voltage. If the battery has just
been returned to 18°C (64°F), the voltage
may be unusually high for the first or second
voltage reading.
(6) Disconnect the lead.
(7) Set the battery in the transmitter.
DL–219
DOOR LOCK – DOOR CONTROL SWITCH
DOOR CONTROL SWITCH
Lock
INSPECTION
1.
Unlock
No Pin (4)
B071970E16
INSPECT DOOR CONTROL SWITCH
(a) Measure the resistance of the switch.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
3-6
Lock
Below 1 Ω
3-5
Unlock
3-6
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
If the result is not as specified, replace the switch.
DL
DL–220
DOOR LOCK – FRONT DOOR LOCK
FRONT DOOR LOCK
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT FRONT DOOR LOCK LH
(a) Apply battery voltage to the door lock and check
operation of the door lock motor.
OK
Measurement Condition
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) →Terminal 4
Battery negative (-) →Terminal 1
Lock
Battery positive (+) →Terminal 1
Battery negative (-) →Terminal 4
Unlock
If the result is not as specified, replace the door lock
assembly.
Unlock
Lock
DL
B079551E05
(b) Measure the resistance of the door lock and unlock
switch and position switch.
Standard resistance
Door lock and unlock switch
Lock
Unlock
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
7-9
Lock
Below 1 Ω
7 - 10
Unlock
7-9
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
7 - 10
Position switch
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
7-8
Lock
Below 1 Ω
7-8
Unlock
10 kΩ or higher
If the result is not as specified, replace the door lock
assembly.
4 3 2 1
10 9 8 7 6 5
B127347E01
DL–221
DOOR LOCK – FRONT DOOR LOCK
2.
INSPECT FRONT DOOR LOCK RH
(a) Apply battery voltage to the door lock and check
operation of the door lock motor.
OK
Measurement Condition
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) →Terminal 4
Battery negative (-) →Terminal 1
Lock
Battery positive (+) →Terminal 1
Battery negative (-) →Terminal 4
Unlock
If the result is not as specified, replace the door lock
assembly.
Unlock
Lock
DL
B079247E07
(b) Measure the resistance of the position switch.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
7-8
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
Lock
Below 1 Ω
Unlock
10 kΩ or higher
If the result is not as specified, replace the door lock
assembly.
Unlock
Lock
B079247E07
DL–222
DOOR LOCK – REAR DOOR LOCK
REAR DOOR LOCK
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT REAR DOOR LOCK LH
(a) Apply battery voltage to the door lock and check
operation of the door lock motor.
OK
Measurement Condition
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) →Terminal 4
Battery negative (-) →Terminal 1
Lock
Battery positive (+) →Terminal 1
Battery negative (-) →Terminal 4
Unlock
If the result is not as specified, replace the door lock
assembly.
Lock
Unlock
DL
B079248E06
(b) Measure the resistance of the position switch.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
6-9
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
Lock
Below 1 Ω
Unlock
10 kΩ or higher
If the result is not as specified, replace the door lock
assembly.
Lock
Unlock
B079248E06
DL–223
DOOR LOCK – REAR DOOR LOCK
2.
INSPECT REAR DOOR LOCK RH
(a) Apply battery voltage to the door lock and check
operation of the door lock motor.
OK
Measurement Condition
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) →Terminal 4
Battery negative (-) →Terminal 1
Lock
Battery positive (+) →Terminal 1
Battery negative (-) →Terminal 4
Unlock
If the result is not as specified, replace the door lock
assembly.
Unlock
Lock
DL
B079249E04
(b) Measure the resistance of the position switch.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
6-9
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
Lock
Below 1 Ω
Unlock
10 kΩ or higher
If the result is not as specified, replace the door lock
assembly.
Unlock
Lock
B079249E04
DL–224
DOOR LOCK – BACK DOOR LOCK
BACK DOOR LOCK
INSPECTION
1.
Pushed (ON)
Not pushed (OFF)
INSPECT BACK DOOR OPENER SWITCH
(a) Measure the resistance of the switch
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Switch Connection
Specified Condition
1-2
Pushed (ON)
Below 1 Ω
Not pushed (OFF)
10 kΩ or higher
B075486E01
If the result is not as specified, replace the switch.
2.
DL
INSPECT BACK DOOR LOCK
(a) Apply battery voltage to the door lock and check
operation the latch.
Standard resistance
Measurement Condition
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) →Terminal 4
Battery negative (-) →Terminal 3
Latch turns to open-latch position
If the result is not as specified, replace the motor.
Position
Full-latch
Open-latch
B079562E01
DL–225
DOOR LOCK – BACK DOOR LOCK
(b) Measure the resistance of the switch.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Switch Connection
Specified Condition
1-2
Open-latch
Below 1 Ω
Half-latch
Full-latch
10 kΩ or higher
Over-latch
If the result is not as specified, replace the door lock
assembly.
Position
DL
Open-latch
Half-latch
Full-latch
Over-latch
B079558E01
DL–226
DOOR LOCK – KEY CANCEL SWITCH
KEY CANCEL SWITCH
INSPECTION
1.
B050965E01
INSPECT KEY CANCEL SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Measure the resistance of the switch.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
Not pushed (OFF)
10 kΩ or higher
1-2
Pushed (ON)
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the switch.
DL
DL–227
DOOR LOCK – ELECTRICAL KEY ANTENNA
ELECTRICAL KEY ANTENNA
INSPECTION
1.
E067622E01
INSPECT ELECTRICAL KEY ANTENNA
(a) Measure the resistance of the outside door handle.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
1-3
Switch pushed
Below 1 Ω
1-3
Switch not pushed
10 kΩ or higher
If the result is not as specified, replace the outside
door handle.
2.
INSPECT ELECTRICAL KEY ANTENNA (LUGGAGE)
(a) Measure the resistance of the antenna.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
Back door lock switch
touched
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the electrical
key antenna (luggage).
B050965E01
DL
DS–1
DRIVE SHAFT – DRIVE SHAFT SYSTEM
DRIVE SHAFT SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
Use the table below to help determine the cause of the
problem symptom. The potential causes of the symptoms are
listed in order of probability in the "Suspected area" column of
the table. Check each symptom by checking the suspected
areas in the order they are listed. Replace parts as
necessary.
Drive shaft system
Symptom
Front wheel shimmy
Noise (front)
Suspected area
See page
1. Front drive shaft (worn)
DS-7
2. Wheel (unbalance)
TW-4
3. Hub bearing
AH-4
4. Front lower ball joint
SP-24
5. Front shock absorber with coil spring
SP-14
1. Front shock absorber with coil spring
SP-14
2. Front drive shaft
DS-7
3. Hub bearing
AH-4
4. Front lower ball joint
SP-24
DS
DS–2
DRIVE SHAFT – FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
DRIVE SHAFT
LINE
COMPONENTS
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY RH
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT HOLE SNAP RING RH
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
HOLE SNAP RING LH
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
ASSEMBLY LH
FRONT SPEED SENSOR LH
FLEXIBLE HOSE
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
29 (296, 21)
CLIP
49 (500, 36)
DS
TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
FRONT AXLE HUB NUT LH
216 (2200, 159)
NO. 1 FRONT SUSPENSION ARM SUB-ASSEMBLY LOWER LH
89 (908, 66)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
B133188E01
DS–3
DRIVE SHAFT – FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT HOLE SNAP RING LH
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT DUST COVER LH
FRONT AXLE INBOARD JOINT BOOT ASSEMBLY LH
FRONT DRIVE INNER SHAFT LH INNER SHAFT SNAP RING
TRIPOD JOINT ASSEMBLY
NO. 2 FRONT AXLE INBOARD
JOINT BOOT CLAMP LH
ONE TOUCH CLAMP TYPE
or
FRONT AXLE INBOARD
JOINT BOOT CLAMP LH
HOOK TYPE
INBOARD JOINT BOOT
or
HOOK TYPE
ONE TOUCH CLAMP TYPE
ONE TOUCH
CLAMP TYPE
OUTBOARD JOINT BOOT
ONE TOUCH CLAMP TYPE
NO. 2 FRONT AXLE OUTBOARD
JOINT BOOT CLAMP LH
Supply Parts (Omega Type)
FRONT AXLE INBOARD
JOINT BOOT CLAMP LH
DS
FRONT AXLE OUTBOARD
JOINT BOOT CLAMP LH
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT OUTBOARD
JOINT SHAFT ASSEMBLY LH
NO. 2 FRONT AXLE
OUTBOARD JOINT BOOT
CLAMP LH
Non-reusable part
B133189E01
DS–4
DRIVE SHAFT – FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
Supply Parts (Omega Type)
NO. 2 FRONT AXLE OUTBOARD
JOINT BOOT CLAMP RH
FRONT AXLE OUTBOARD
JOINT BOOT CLAMP RH
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT OUTBOARD JOINT SHAFT ASSEMBLY RH
NO. 2 FRONT AXLE OUTBOARD JOINT BOOT CLAMP RH
OUTBOARD JOINT BOOT
FRONT AXLE OUTBOARD
JOINT BOOT CLAMP RH
DRIVE SHAFT DAMPER
SETTING CLAMP
ONE TOUCH
CLAMP TYPE
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT DAMPER RH
or
or
HOOK TYPE
INBOARD JOINT BOOT
FRONT AXLE INBOARD JOINT
BOOT CLAMP RH
DS
ONE TOUCH CLAMP TYPE
HOOK TYPE
NO. 2 FRONT AXLE
INBOARD JOINT
BOOT RH LAMP
Non-reusable part
or
TRIPOD JOINT ASSEMBLY
FRONT AXLE INBOARD JOINT
ASSEMBLY RH
FRONT DRIVE INNER SHAFT
RH INNER SHAFT SNAP RING
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
DUST COVER RH
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT HOLE SNAP RING RH
B133197E01
DRIVE SHAFT – FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
DS–5
REMOVAL
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
DRAIN TRANSAXLE OIL
(a) Using a 10 mm socket hexagon wrench, remove the
drain plug and gasket, and drain the fluid.
(b) Using a socket hexagon wrench, tighten the drain
plug with a new gasket placed inside.
Torque: 39 N*m (400 kgf*cm, 29 ft.*lbf)
2.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
3.
REMOVE FRONT AXLE HUB NUT LH
(a) Using SST and a hammer, unstake the axle hub nut.
SST 09930-00010
NOTICE:
• Place SST on the flat part of the nut's recess.
• Do not grind the SST tip with a grinder or
equivalent.
• Unstake the front axle hub nut completely
when removing it.
• Do not damage the front drive shaft LH
threads.
(b) Using a 30 mm socket wrench, remove the axle hub
nut.
4.
REMOVE FRONT SPEED SENSOR LH
(a) Remove the bolt and disconnect the speed sensor
wire and flexible hose clamp from the shock
absorber.
SST
F047428E01
DS
C080291E01
(b) Remove the bolt and front speed sensor from the
steering knuckle.
NOTICE:
Keep both the tip and installation part of the
speed sensor free of foreign matter.
G028132E01
DS–6
DRIVE SHAFT – FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
5.
DISCONNECT TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the clip and castle nut.
(b) Using SST, disconnect the tie rod end from the
steering knuckle.
SST 09628-00011
NOTICE:
• Do not damage the front disc brake dust
cover.
• Be sure to hang the tie rod end with a string
to prevent SST from dropping.
• Do not damage the ball joint dust cover.
• Do not damage the steering knuckle.
• Securely hang SST to the spacer of the
steering knuckle.
• Replace the steering knuckle with a new one
if the spacer comes off the steering knuckle.
6.
DISCONNECT NO. 1 FRONT SUSPENSION ARM
SUB-ASSEMBLY LOWER LH
(a) Remove the bolt and 2 nuts.
(b) Push down the No. 1 front suspension lower arm
and disconnect the front lower ball joint.
7.
REMOVE FRONT AXLE ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Using a plastic-faced hammer, tap the end of the
front drive shaft and disengage the fitting between
the front drive shaft and front axle.
HINT:
If it is difficult to disengage, tap the end of the front
drive shaft LH with a brass bar and hammer.
(b) Push the front axle outward from the vehicle to
remove the front drive shaft from the front axle.
NOTICE:
• Be careful not to push the front axle outward
from the vehicle more than necessary to
remove it.
• Be careful not to damage the front axle out
board joint boot.
• Be careful not to damage the speed sensor
rotor.
• Hang the drive shaft down with a string or
equivalent.
SST
Hold
Turn
F047429E01
C080293E01
DS
DRIVE SHAFT – FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
8.
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the front fender apron seal.
(b) Hook the SST claw at position (1) in the illustration
to remove the front drive shaft.
SST 09520-01010, 09520-24010 (09520-32040)
NOTICE:
• Be careful not to damage the oil seal.
• Be careful not to damage the front drive shaft
boot.
• Be careful not to drop the front drive shaft.
HINT:
If the front drive shaft cannot be removed at position
(1) in the illustration, hook the SST claw at position
(2) in the illustration in order to remove it.
9.
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY RH
HINT:
Remove the front drive shaft RH following the same
procedures as the LH side.
SST
(2)
(1)
F047430E02
SST
F047431E01
DS–7
10. FIX FRONT AXLE ASSEMBLY LH
HINT:
The hub bearing could be damaged if it is subjected to
the vehicle's full weight, such as when moving the
vehicle with the drive shaft removed. If it is absolutely
necessary to place the vehicle's weight on the hub
bearing, first support it with SST.
SST 09608-16042 (09608-02021, 09608-02041)
11. INSPECT FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Check for noticeable looseness when turning the
joint up and down, left and right, and in the thrust
direction.
(b) Check for cracks, damage or grease leaks on the
joint boot.
NOTICE:
Carry the drive shaft levelly.
DS
DS–8
DRIVE SHAFT – FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
DISASSEMBLY
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
REMOVE NO. 2 FRONT AXLE INBOARD JOINT
BOOT CLAMP LH
(a) When using a one touch clamp:
Using a flat-head screwdriver, unstake the No. 2
inboard joint boot clamp and separate the No. 2
inboard joint boot clamp.
C067083E01
(b) When using a hook type:
Using needle-nose pliers, unhook and remove the
No. 2 inboard joint boot clamp.
F047432E01
2.
DS
REMOVE FRONT AXLE INBOARD JOINT BOOT LH
CLAMP
(a) When using a one touch clamp:
Using a flat-head screwdriver, separate the inboard
joint boot clamp and separate the inboard joint boot
clamp.
C067084E01
(b) When using a hook type:
Using needle-nose pliers, unhook and remove the
inboard joint boot clamp.
F047433E01
3.
DISCONNECT FRONT AXLE INBOARD JOINT BOOT
(a) Disconnect the inboard joint boot from the inboard
joint.
4.
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE INBOARD JOINT
ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove grease from the inboard joint.
DRIVE SHAFT – FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
DS–9
(b) Put matchmarks on the inboard joint and outboard
joint.
NOTICE:
Do not make matchmarks with a punch and
hammer.
(c) Remove the inboard joint from the outboard joint.
(d) Hold the outboard joint with vise aluminum plates in
between.
NOTICE:
Do not overtighten the vise.
Matchmark
F047434E03
(e) Using a snap ring expander, remove the front drive
inner shaft snap ring.
F046838E01
(f)
Put matchmarks on the tripod joint and outboard
joint.
NOTICE:
Do not make matchmarks with a punch and
hammer.
(g) Using a brass bar and hammer, tap out the tripod
joint.
NOTICE:
Do not hit the roller position.
(h) Remove the No. 2 inboard joint boot clamp, inboard
joint boot and inboard joint boot clamp.
Matchmark
F047435E03
5.
One Touch Clamp Type
Hook Type
6.
F047436E04
REMOVE DRIVE SHAFT DAMPER SETTING CLAMP
HINT:
Perform this procedure only when overhauling the RH
side.
(a) When using a one touch clamp:
Using a flat-head screwdriver, remove the drive
shaft damper clamp.
(b) When using a hook type:
Using needle-nose pliers, unhook and remove the
drive shaft damper clamp.
(c) Remove the drive shaft damper from the outboard
joint LH.
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT DAMPER RH
DS
DS–10
DRIVE SHAFT – FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
7.
REMOVE NO. 2 FRONT AXLE OUTBOARD JOINT
BOOT CLAMP LH
(a) Using a flat-head screwdriver, remove the No. 2
outboard joint boot clamp.
8.
REMOVE FRONT AXLE OUTBOARD JOINT BOOT
CLAMP LH
(a) Using a flat-head screwdriver, remove the outboard
joint boot clamp.
9.
REMOVE OUTBOARD JOINT BOOT
(a) Remove the outboard joint boot from the outboard
joint LH.
(b) Remove grease from the outboard joint.
C063445E01
C063444E01
10. REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT HOLE SNAP RING
LH
(a) Using a flat-head screwdriver, remove the front
drive shaft hole snap ring.
C057543E01
DS
11. REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT DUST COVER LH
(a) Using SST and a press, press out the front drive
shaft dust cover.
SST 09950-00020
NOTICE:
Be careful not to drop the inboard joint.
SST
F047437E02
12. REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT DUST COVER RH
HINT:
Remove the front drive shaft dust cover RH following the
same procedures as the LH side.
SST 09950-00020
DRIVE SHAFT – FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
DS–11
REASSEMBLY
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT DUST COVER LH
(a) Using SST and a press, install a new front drive
shaft dust cover and press it in until it contacts the
end of the inboard joint.
SST 09527-10011
NOTICE:
• Install the front driver shaft dust cover LH in
the correct direction.
• Do not deform the front drive shaft dust cover
LH.
2.
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT DUST COVER RH
HINT:
Install the front drive shaft dust cover RH following the
same procedures as the LH side.
SST 09527-10011
3.
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT HOLE SNAP RING
LH
(a) Install a new front drive shaft hole snap ring.
4.
INSTALL OUTBOARD JOINT BOOT
(a) Wrap protective tape around the spline of the
outboard joint.
(b) Install the following new parts on the outboard joint
LH in order.
(1) No. 2 outboard joint boot clamp LH
(2) Outboard joint boot
(3) Outboard joint boot clamp LH
(c) Apply grease to the joint of the outboard joint LH
and outboard joint boot.
Standard capacity:
125 to 135 g (4.9 to 5.3 oz.)
(d) Install the outboard joint boot into the outboard joint
groove.
NOTICE:
Do not apply grease in the groove.
SST
F047438E01
5.
Hold
SST
Turn
F047439E01
INSTALL NO. 2 FRONT AXLE OUTBOARD JOINT
BOOT CLAMP LH
(a) Hold the front drive shaft in a vise between 2
aluminum plates.
NOTICE:
Do not overtighten the vise.
(b) Set SST to the No. 2 outboard joint boot clamp and
slightly tighten the SST bolt while pushing the
outboard joint on.
SST 09521-24010
(c) Hold SST and tighten the SST bolt so that the
clearance is within the specified value.
Standard clearance:
0.8 mm (0.031 in.) or less
DS
DS–12
DRIVE SHAFT – FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
NOTICE:
Do not damage the outboard joint.
(d) Remove SST.
(e) Using SST, measure the clearance of the No. 2
outboard joint boot clamp LH.
SST 09240-00020
Standard clearance:
0.8 mm (0.031 in.) or less
NOTICE:
If the clearance exceeds the maximum, retighten
it.
SST
F047440E01
6.
Hold
SST
Turn
F047441E01
INSTALL FRONT AXLE OUTBOARD JOINT BOOT
CLAMP LH
(a) Set SST to the outboard joint boot clamp LH and
slightly tighten the SST bolt while pushing the
outboard joint on.
(b) Hold SST and tighten the SST bolt so that the
clearance is within the specified value.
SST 09521-24010
Standard clearance:
0.8 mm (0.031 in.) or less
NOTICE:
Do not damage the outboard joint.
(c) Remove SST.
(d) Using SST, measure the clearance of the outboard
joint boot clamp LH.
SST 09240-00020
Standard clearance:
0.8 mm (0.031 in.) or less
NOTICE:
If the clearance exceeds the maximum, retighten
it.
SST
DS
7.
F047442E01
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT DAMPER RH
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH
side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
DRIVE SHAFT – FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
DS–13
(a) Install the drive shaft damper to the outboard joint
LH.
Standard distance:
427 +-2.0 mm (16.81 +-0.079 in.)
NOTICE:
Install in the correct direction.
427 +-2.0 mm
F047443E03
8.
INSTALL DRIVE SHAFT DAMPER SETTING CLAMP
(a) When using a one touch clamp:
Install the drive shaft damper clamp to the drive
shaft damper and stake the drive shaft damper
clamp using a flat-head screwdriver.
(b) When using a hook type:
Using needle-nose pliers, align the concave part
and protrusion of the drive shaft damper clamp in
order to lock it.
9.
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE INBOARD JOINT ASSEMBLY
LH
(a) Install the following new parts on the outboard joint
LH in order.
(1) Inboard joint boot clamp
(2) Inboard joint boot
(3) No. 2 inboard joint boot clamp
(b) Hold the drive shaft in a vise between 2 aluminum
plates.
NOTICE:
Do not overtighten the vise.
(c) Remove the protective tape.
One Touch Clamp Type
Hook Type
A125218E02
DS
DS–14
DRIVE SHAFT – FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
Matchmark
F047445E02
(d) Align the matchmarks and install the tripod joint onto
the outboard joint.
NOTICE:
Face the serration side of the tripod joint
outward and install it to the outboard joint end.
(e) Using a brass bar and hammer, drive the tripod joint
in.
NOTICE:
• Do not hit the roller portion.
• Do not attach any foreign matter on the tripod
joint.
(f)
Using a snap ring expander, install a new front drive
inner shaft snap ring.
(g) Fill grease in the joint of the inboard joint and
outboard joint boot.
Standard capacity:
125 to 135 g (4.9 to 5.3 oz.)
F047446E01
(h) Align the matchmarks and install the inboard joint
onto the outboard joint.
Matchmark
10. INSTALL FRONT AXLE INBOARD JOINT BOOT
(a) Install the inboard joint boot into the inboard joint LH
and outboard joint LH grooves.
NOTICE:
Do not apply grease in the groove.
F047447E02
11. INSTALL NO. 2 FRONT AXLE INBOARD JOINT BOOT
CLAMP LH
(a) When using a one touch clamp:
Install the No. 2 inboard joint boot clamp LH to the
inboard joint boot and stake the No. 2 inboard joint
boot clamp LH using a flat-head screwdriver.
NOTICE:
Do not scratch the inboard joint boot.
DS
C081794E01
(b) When using a hook type:
Using needle-nose pliers, align the concave part
with the protrusion of the No. 2 inboard joint boot
clamp LH in order to lock it.
NOTICE:
• Do not scratch the inboard joint boot.
• Do not deform the claw of the hook.
F047448E01
DS–15
DRIVE SHAFT – FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
12. INSTALL FRONT AXLE INBOARD JOINT BOOT
CLAMP LH
(a) When using a one touch clamp:
Install the inboard joint boot clamp to the inboard
joint boot and stake the inboard joint boot clamp
using a flat-head screwdriver.
NOTICE:
Do not scratch the inboard joint boot.
C081795E01
(b) When using a hook type:
Using needle-nose pliers, align the concave part
with the protrusion of the No. 2 inboard joint boot
clamp in order to lock it.
NOTICE:
• Do not scratch the inboard joint boot.
• Do not deform the claw of the hook.
F047449E01
13. INSPECT FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Check if the front drive shaft is within the following
dimension.
Standard dimension (A)
(A)
F047450E01
LH
RH
564.3 mm (22.216 in.)
846.3 mm (33.319 in.)
(b) Check for noticeable looseness when turning the
joint up and down, left and right, and in the thrust
direction.
(c) Check for cracks, damage or grease leaks on the
joint boot.
NOTICE:
Carry the front drive shaft LH levelly.
DS
DS–16
DRIVE SHAFT – FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
INSTALLATION
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Apply ATF to the spline of the inboard joint.
(b) Align the spline of the front drive shaft and insert the
front drive shaft using a brass bar and hammer.
NOTICE:
• Face the snap ring cut area downward.
• Be careful not to damage the oil seal.
• Be careful not to damage the front drive shaft
boot.
HINT:
Judge whether the front drive shaft is securely
driven in or not according to the brass bar reaction
force or sound change.
(c) Install the front fender apron seal.
2.
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY RH
HINT:
Install the front drive shaft dust cover RH following the
same procedures as the LH side.
3.
INSTALL FRONT AXLE ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Push the front axle outward from the vehicle to align
the spline of the front drive shaft with the front axle
and insert.
NOTICE:
• Be careful not to push the front axle outward
from the vehicle more than necessary to
remove it.
• Be careful not to damage the oil seal.
• Be careful not to damage the front drive shaft
LH boot.
• Be careful not to damage the speed sensor
rotor.
• Check for any foreign matter on the speed
sensor rotor and insertion part.
4.
CONNECT NO. 1 FRONT SUSPENSION ARM SUBASSEMBLY LOWER LH
(a) Push the No. 1 front suspension lower arm
downward, install the front lower ball joint and
tighten the bolt and 2 nuts.
Torque: 89 N*m (908 kgf*cm, 66 ft.*lbf)
5.
CONNECT TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Connect the tie rod end to the steering knuckle and
install it with the castle nut.
NOTICE:
The clip hole alignment should be done after
tightening the castle nut up to 60°beyond the
torque specification.
Torque: 49 N*m (500 kgf*cm, 36 ft.*lbf)
(b) Install a new clip.
C081127E01
DS
C080293E01
DRIVE SHAFT – FRONT DRIVE SHAFT
6.
DS–17
INSTALL FRONT SPEED SENSOR LH
(a) Connect the front speed sensor wire and flexible
hose clamp to the shock absorber with the bolt.
Torque: 29 N*m (296 kgf*cm, 21 ft.*lbf)
C080291E01
(b) Install the front speed sensor to the steering
knuckle.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
NOTICE:
• Do not damage the speed sensor tip when
installing the speed sensor.
• Ensure no foreign object is caught when
tightening the bolt.
• Do not twist the sensor wire when installing
the speed sensor.
G028132E01
C068609E01
7.
INSTALL FRONT AXLE HUB NUT LH
(a) Using a 30 mm socket wrench, install a new hub
nut.
Torque: 216 N*m (2,200 kgf*cm, 159 ft.*lbf)
(b) Using a chisel and hammer, stake the hub nut.
8.
INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
Torque: 103 N*m (1,050 kgf*cm, 76 ft.*lbf)
9.
ADD TRANSAXLE OIL
10. INSPECT TRANSAXLE OIL (See page HX-130)
11. INSPECT AND ADJUST FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
(See page SP-3)
12. CHECK ABS SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL (See page BC219)
DS
EC–1
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM
EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL
ENGINE
PARTS LOCATION
VENTILATION VALVE
PURGE VSV
EC
AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
(for Bank 1 Sensor 1)
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
(for Bank 1 Sensor 2)
FUEL TANK CAP
FUEL TANK PRESSURE SENSOR
FRESH AIR LINE
PURGE LINE
CANISTER PRESSURE
SWITCHING VALVE
CANISTER
FILTER
CANISTER
TRAP CANISTER
- CANISTER PUMP MODULE
VENT LINE
A128659E01
EC–2
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
The emission control system is controlled by the ECM based
on signals from various sensors.
Ventilation Valve
Air Fuel Ratio Sensor
EC
Heated Oxygen Sensor
Catalyst
Purge Line
Purge VSV
Canister
Fuel Cap
Pressure Switching Valve
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor
Vent Line
Trap Canister with Pump Module
Canister Filter
Fresh Air Line
Fuel
Pump
Chamber
Roll-Over Valve
Bladder Tank
A128666E01
EC–3
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM
ECM
EFI
MREL
Purge VSV
EVP1
Heated Oxygen Sensor
+B
HT
HT1B
E
OX
OX1B
EC
Shielded
EFI
Air Fuel Ratio Sensor
+B
AF+
A1A+
HT
AF-
A1AShielded
P/I
HA1A
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor
PTNK
MAIN
PTNK
E2
VCC
VC
E2
Sub
Battery
A
B
C
A128667E01
EC–4
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM
A
B
C
Canister Pump Module
SGND
Canister
Pressure
Sensor
VOUT
PPMP
VCC
EC
MGND
E1
Leak
Detection M
Pump
MTRB
VLVB
VGND
MPMP
+B
VPMP
Pressure Switching Valve
TBP
A128668E01
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – EMISSION CONTROL SYSTEM
EC–5
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT FUEL CUT OFF RPM
(a) Check the operation.
(1) Stat the engine, then warm up it.
(2) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(3) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(4) Select the item: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / USER DATA /
INJECTOR.
(5) Drive the vehicle. When releasing the
accelerator pedal after the vehicle speed is 45
to 60 km/h (28 to 37 mph), read "INJECTOR"
on the intelligent tester.
Standard:
0 ms
2.
CHECK AIR INLET LINE
(a) Check the ventilation.
(1) Disconnect the ventilation hose (see page FU23).
(2) Check that there is ventilation from the canister
filter to the fuel tank inlet pipe when air is
applied to the vent hose of the canister filter.
If there is no ventilation, replace the canister
filter.
(3) Connect the ventilation hose (see page FU-32).
Intelligent Tester
DLC3
A087542E01
Air
A088405E01
3.
A087597E01
VISUALLY CHECK HOSES, CONNECTIONS AND
GASKETS
(a) Check the appearance.
(1) Visually check that there are no cracks, leaks
or damage on the indicated portions in the
illustration.
HINT:
• Removing the oil level gauge, oil filler cap or
ventilation hoses may cause the engine
malfunction or engine stall.
• If the parts between the mass air flow meter
and cylinder head are disconnected, loose
or cracked, secondary air may be sucked. If
could cause the engine malfunction or
engine stall.
EC
EC–6
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – CANISTER
CANISTER
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
LOWER CENTER INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL
x2
CLIP
CLIP
EC
POWER OUTLET CONNECTOR
GASKET
FRONT FLOOR CARPET
COMPRESSION SPRING
FRONT EXHAUST PIPE
43 (440, 32)
x2
GASKET
x2
43 (440, 32)
x4
COMPRESSION SPRING
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
30 (302, 22)
FRONT FLOOR PANEL BRACE
Non-reusable part
A131462E01
EC–7
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – CANISTER
REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY
REAR FLOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER
FUEL TANK INLET PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY
EC
WIRE TO WIRE CONNECTOR
FUEL TUBE CONNECTOR
FUEL PUMP CONNECTOR
FUEL FILLER PIPE CLAMP
NO. 1 FUEL TANK BAND
SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
FUEL TANK SUB-ASSEMBLY
NO. 1 FUEL TANK BAND
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
x2
39 (400, 29)
x2
39 (400, 29)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A131463E01
EC–8
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – CANISTER
6.0 (61, 53 in.*lbf)
CANISTER HOSE
CLAMP
EC
CANISTER
NO. 1 CANISTER OUTLET HOSE
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A128660E01
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – CANISTER
EC–9
REMOVAL
1.
DISCHARGE FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE (See page
FU-12)
2.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
3.
REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-4)
4.
REMOVE REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
5.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
6.
REMOVE LOWER CENTER INSTRUMENT PANEL
FINISH PANEL (See page IP-18)
7.
REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY (See
page SE-15)
8.
REMOVE REAR FLOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER (See
page FU-23)
9.
REMOVE FRONT FLOOR PANEL BRACE (See page
EX-2)
10. REMOVE FRONT EXHAUST PIPE
(a) Using a clip remover, remove the clip.
(b) Fold back the front floor carpet.
A087436E01
(c) Disconnect the heated oxygen sensor connector.
(d) Remove the grommet of the heated oxygen sensor
from the vehicle.
(e) Remove the 2 bolts and 2 compression springs.
(f) Remove the gasket from the front exhaust pipe.
(g) Disconnect the tail pipe from the front exhaust pipe.
(h) Remove the 2 bolts and 2 compression springs.
(i) Remove the front exhaust pipe from the 2 exhaust
pipe supports.
A087437E01
EC
EC–10
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – CANISTER
(j)
Remove the gasket from the exhaust manifold.
EC
A086203
11. REMOVE FUEL TANK SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page
FU-23)
12. REMOVE CANISTER
(a) Disconnect the pressure switching valve connector.
(b) Remove the clamp.
(c) Remove the wire harness clamp.
A087525E01
(d) Remove the clamp.
(e) Disconnect the 2 canister hoses from the fuel tank
retainer and fuel tank to canister tube.
(f) Disconnect the No. 1 canister outlet hose from the
fuel tank.
A087524E01
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – CANISTER
EC–11
(g) Remove the bolt and 2 nuts, then remove the
canister.
A087526E01
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT CANISTER
(a) Check the appearance.
(1) Check that there are no cracks or damage on
the indicated portions of the canister.
If there are any defects, replace the canister.
EC
A087562E01
(b) Check the ventilation.
(1) Disconnect the charcoal canister hose from the
canister.
(2) Remove the No. 1 canister outlet hose from the
canister.
A087563E01
(3) Check that there is ventilation from port B when
air of 4.9 kPa (50 gf/cm2, 0.71 psi) is applied to
port A with the port C plugged with your finger.
If there is no ventilation, replace the canister.
C
B
A
A087564E01
(4) Check that there is ventilation from ports B and
C when air (4.9 kPa (50 gf/cm2, 0.71 psi)) is
applied to canister vent hose.
If there is no ventilation, replace the canister.
C
B
A
A087565E01
EC–12
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – CANISTER
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL CANISTER
(a) Install the canister with the bolt and 2 nuts.
Torque: 6.0 N*m (61 kgf*cm, 53 in.*lbf)
A087526E01
(b) Connect the No. 1 canister outlet hose to the fuel
tank.
(c) Connect the 2 canister hoses to the fuel tank
retainer and fuel tank to canister tube.
(d) Install the clamp.
EC
A087524E01
(e) Install the wire clamp harness.
(f) Install the clamp.
(g) Connect the pressure switching valve connector.
2.
INSTALL FUEL TANK SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page FU35)
3.
INSTALL FRONT EXHAUST PIPE
(a) Using a vernier caliper, measure the free length of
the compression spring.
Minimum length:
40.5 mm (1.594 in.)
If the length is less than the minimum, replace the
compression spring.
A087525E01
A111834
Wooden
Block
Gasket
A076194E04
(b) Using a plastic-faced hammer and wooden block,
tap in a new gasket until its surface is flush with the
exhaust manifold.
NOTICE:
• Tap in the gasket in the correct direction.
• Do not reuse the removed gasket.
• Do not push in the gasket while installing the
exhaust pipe.
(c) Connect the 2 exhaust pipe supports, and install the
exhaust pipe.
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – CANISTER
EC–13
(d) Install the 2 compression springs and 2 bolts.
Torque: 43 N*m (438 kgf*cm, 32 ft.*lbf)
(e) Install the grommet of the heated oxygen sensor to
the vehicle.
(f) Connect the heated oxygen sensor connector.
(g) Install the front floor carpet with the clip.
4.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL (See page CH-7)
5.
CHECK FOR FUEL LEAKS (See page FU-8)
6.
CHECK FOR EXHAUST GAS LEAKS (See page EX-4)
7.
INSTALL FRONT FLOOR PANEL BRACE (See page
EX-4)
8.
INSTALL REAR FLOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER (See
page FU-38)
9.
INSTALL REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY (See
page SE-23)
A087437
10. INSTALL LOWER CENTER INSTRUMENT PANEL
FINISH PANEL (See page IP-21)
11. INSTALL REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
12. INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-8)
13. INSTALL REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
14. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
EC
EC–14
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – TRAP CANISTER
TRAP CANISTER
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
LOWER CENTER INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL
x2
CLIP
CLIP
EC
POWER OUTLET CONNECTOR
GASKET
FRONT FLOOR CARPET
COMPRESSION SPRING
FRONT EXHAUST PIPE
43 (440, 32)
x2
GASKET
x2
43 (440, 32)
x4
COMPRESSION SPRING
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
30 (302, 22)
FRONT FLOOR PANEL BRACE
Non-reusable part
A131462E02
EC–15
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – TRAP CANISTER
REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY
REAR FLOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER
FUEL TANK INLET PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY
EC
WIRE TO WIRE CONNECTOR
FUEL TUBE CONNECTOR
FUEL PUMP CONNECTOR
FUEL FILLER PIPE CLAMP
NO. 1 FUEL TANK BAND
SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
FUEL TANK SUB-ASSEMBLY
NO. 1 FUEL TANK BAND
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
x2
39 (400, 29)
x2
39 (400, 29)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A131463E02
EC–16
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – TRAP CANISTER
6.0 (61, 53 in.*lbf)
FUEL TANK WIRE
CLAMP
EC
TRAP CANISTER WITH
PUMP MODULE
FUEL TANK VENT
SUB-ASSEMBLY
FUEL TANK BREATHER
TUBE GASKET
CANISTER PUMP MODULE CONNECTOR
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A128662E01
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – TRAP CANISTER
EC–17
REMOVAL
1.
DISCHARGE FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE (See page
FU-12)
2.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
3.
REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-4)
4.
REMOVE REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
5.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
6.
REMOVE LOWER CENTER INSTRUMENT PANEL
FINISH PANEL (See page IP-18)
7.
REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY (See
page SE-15)
8.
REMOVE REAR FLOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER (See
page FU-23)
9.
REMOVE FRONT FLOOR PANEL BRACE (See page
EX-2)
10. REMOVE FRONT EXHAUST PIPE (See page EC-9)
11. REMOVE FUEL TANK SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page
FU-23)
12. REMOVE TRAP CANISTER WITH PUMP MODULE
(a) Remove the clamp from the fuel tank vent hose and
canister hose.
(b) Remove the tube of the fuel tank main tube from the
clamp.
(c) Remove the tube of the fuel tank to canister tube
from the clamp.
(d) Remove the tube of the fuel tank vent hose from the
2 fuel tube with No. 1 grommet clamps.
A128670
(e) Disconnect the canister pump module connector.
(f) Remove the 2 bolts, then remove the trap canister
with pump module and ground terminal of the fuel
tank wire.
A128671
EC
EC–18
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – TRAP CANISTER
(g) Remove the gasket from the fuel tank.
A087502E01
(h) Remove the 2 clamps from the trap canister with
pump module.
EC
A128672
(i)
Pinch
Push
Fuel Tank Vent Hose Connector
Pipe
Retainer
O-Ring
Nylon Tube
A112317E01
Pinch the retainer and pull out the fuel tank vent
connector with the fuel tank vent hose connector
pushed to the fuel tank vent hose side to disconnect
the fuel tank vent hose from the trap canister with
pump module.
NOTICE:
• Remove dirt or foreign objects on the fuel
tank vent hose connector before this work
procedure.
• Do not allow any scratches or foreign objects
on the parts when disconnecting them as the
fuel tank vent hose connector has the O-ring
that seals the pipe.
• Perform this work by hand. Do not use any
tools.
• Do not forcibly bend, twist or turn the nylon
tube.
• Protect the connecting part by covering it
with a plastic bag after disconnecting the fuel
tank vent hose.
• If the fuel tank vent hose connector and pipe
are stuck, push and pull them to release
them.
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – TRAP CANISTER
EC–19
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT TRAP CANISTER WITH PUMP MODULE
(a) Check the appearance.
(1) Check that there are no cracks or damage on
the indicated portion of the trap canister with
pump module.
If there are any defects, replace the trap
canister with pump module.
A128675
(b) Check the ventilation.
(1) Remove the 2 bolts and canister pump module.
EC
A128676
(2) Check that there is ventilation from port A when
air is applied to port B.
If there is no ventilation, replace the trap
canister with pump module.
B
A
Air
A087568E01
(c) Check the leak detection pump.
(1) Check that air flows from port A to port B and
C.
If the result is not as specified, replace the
canister.
A
Air
B
A131292E01
Valve
7
Closed
6
A131293E01
(2) Connect the positive (+) lead of the battery to
terminal 7 and the negative (-) lead to terminal
6. Check that the valve is closed.
If the result is not as specified, replace the trap
with outlet valve canister.
(3) Install the canister pump module.
EC–20
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – TRAP CANISTER
INSTALLATION
1.
Push
A128674E01
EC
INSTALL TRAP CANISTER WITH PUMP MODULE
(a) Install the fuel tank vent hose.
(1) Align the fuel tank vent hose connector with the
pipe, then push in the fuel tank vent hose
connector until the retainer makes a "click"
sound to install the fuel tank vent hose to the
trap canister with pump module.
NOTICE:
• Check that there are no scratches or
foreign objects around the connected
part of the fuel tank vent hose connector
and pipe before this procedure.
• After connecting the fuel tank vent hose,
check that the fuel tank vent hose is
securely connected by pulling the fuel
tank vent hose connector.
(b) Install a new gasket to the fuel tank.
(c) While being careful that the gasket does not drop in
the fuel tank, insert the trap canister with pump
module to the fuel tank.
(d) Install the trap canister with pump module and
ground terminal of the fuel tank wire with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 6.0 N*m (61 kgf*cm, 53 in.*lbf)
(e) Install the tube of the fuel tank vent hose to the 2
No. 1 fuel tube with grommet clamps.
(f) Install the clamp to the fuel tank vent hose and
canister hose.
(g) Connect the canister pump module connector.
(h) Install the fuel tank vent hose to the 2 No. 1 fuel
tube with grommet clamps.
(i) Install the tube of the fuel tank to canister tube to the
clamp.
(j) Install the tube of the fuel tank main tube to the
clamp.
(k) Install the clamp to the fuel tank vent hose and
canister hose.
A087504E01
2.
INSTALL FUEL TANK SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page FU35)
3.
INSTALL FRONT EXHAUST PIPE (See page EC-12)
4.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL (See page CH-7)
5.
CHECK FOR FUEL LEAKS (See page FU-8)
6.
CHECK FOR EXHAUST GAS LEAKS (See page EX-4)
7.
INSTALL FRONT FLOOR PANEL BRACE (See page
EX-4)
8.
INSTALL REAR FLOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER (See
page FU-38)
9.
INSTALL REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY (See
page SE-23)
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – TRAP CANISTER
EC–21
10. INSTALL LOWER CENTER INSTRUMENT PANEL
FINISH PANEL (See page IP-21)
11. INSTALL REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
12. INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-8)
13. INSTALL REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
14. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
EC
EC–22
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – VACUUM SWITCHING VALVE
VACUUM SWITCHING VALVE
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
PURGE LINE HOSE
PURGE VSV CONNECTOR
PURGE LINE HOSE
EC
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
PURGE VSV
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A128665E01
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – VACUUM SWITCHING VALVE
EC–23
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
2.
REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-4)
3.
REMOVE REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
4.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
5.
REMOVE PURGE VSV
(a) Disconnect the purge VSV connector.
(b) Disconnect the 2 purge line hoses from the purge
VSV.
(c) Remove the bolt, then remove the purge VSV.
A087598E01
INSPECTION
1.
A086290E02
INSPECT PURGE VSV
(a) Inspect the resistance.
(1) Measure the resistance between the terminals.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1-2
26 to 30 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the
purge VSV.
(b) Check the ventilation.
(1) Check that there is no ventilation from port F
when air is applied to port E.
If there is ventilation, replace the purge VSV.
Air
E
F
A086292E01
EC
EC–24
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – VACUUM SWITCHING VALVE
(2) Apply battery voltage across the terminals.
(3) Check that there is ventilation from port F when
air is applied to port E.
If there is no ventilation, replace the purge VSV.
Air
E
F
Battery
A086293E01
INSTALLATION
EC
A087598E01
1.
INSTALL PURGE VSV
(a) Install the purge VSV with the bolt.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (76 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
(b) Connect the 2 purge line hoses to the purge VSV.
(c) Connect the purge VSV connector.
2.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL (See page CH-7)
3.
INSTALL REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
4.
INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-8)
5.
INSTALL REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
6.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
EC–25
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – VENTILATION VALVE
VENTILATION VALVE
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
7.0 (71, 62 in.*lbf)
WIRE HARNESS
3.0 (31, 27 in.*lbf)
CLAMP
EC
3.0 (31, 27 in.*lbf)
NO. 1 AIR CLEANER INLET
CLAMP
BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER
RESERVOIR COVER
27 (275, 20)
VENTILATION VALVE
ENGINE ROOM NO. 2
RELAY BLOCK
8.4 (86, 74 in.*lbf)
VENTILATION HOSE
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A128677E01
EC–26
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – VENTILATION VALVE
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
2.
REMOVE REAR FLOOR DECK BOX (See page CH-4)
3.
REMOVE REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
4.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
5.
REMOVE ENGINE ROOM NO. 2 RELAY BLOCK
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and relay block.
(b) Remove the 4 wire harness clamps.
6.
REMOVE AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
(a) Loosen the clamp, then disconnect the No. 1 air
cleaner inlet from the air cleaner case.
EC
A087418E02
A086911E01
(b) Disconnect the mass air flow meter connector, then
remove the wire harness clamp.
(c) Loosen the 2 clamps, then remove the 2 bolts and
air cleaner assembly.
A087334E01
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – VENTILATION VALVE
7.
EC–27
REMOVE WIRE HARNESS
(a) Disconnect the fuel injector connector and ignition
coil connector.
(b) Remove the 3 bolts and wire harness clamp, then
disconnect the wire harness.
A087340E01
(c) Remove the brake master cylinder reservoir cover.
EC
A087341E01
8.
REMOVE VENTILATION VALVE
(a) Disconnect the ventilation hose.
(b) Remove the ventilation valve.
A128678
Cylinder Head Side
Clean Hose
A059511E11
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT VENTILATION VALVE
(a) Check the ventilation.
(1) Install a clean hose to the ventilation valve as
illustration.
(2) Check that there is ventilation when air is
applied to the cylinder head side.
CAUTION:
Do not suck the air inside the ventilation
valve because it is harmful.
If there is no ventilation, replace the ventilation
valve.
EC–28
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – VENTILATION VALVE
(3) Check that there no ventilation when air is
applied to the intake manifold side.
If there is ventilation, replace the ventilation
valve.
Intake Manifold Side
Clean Hose
A059512E10
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL VENTILATION VALVE
(a) Install the ventilation valve onto the cylinder head
cover.
Torque: 27 N*m (275 kgf*cm, 20 ft.*lbf)
2.
INSTALL ENGINE WIRE
(a) Install the brake master cylinder reservoir cover to
the cylinder head cover.
EC
A128678
A087341E01
(b) Install the wire harness and brake master cylinder
reservoir cover with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 9.0 N*m (92 kgf*cm, 80 in.*lbf)
(c) Connect the fuel injector connector and ignition coil
connector.
A087340E01
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – VENTILATION VALVE
3.
EC–29
INSTALL AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the air cleaner with the 2 bolts and tighten the
clamp.
Torque: 7.0 N*m (71 kgf*cm, 62 in.*lbf) for bolt
3.0 N*m (31 kgf*cm, 27 in.*lbf) for clamp
A087334E01
(b) Connect the No. 1 air cleaner inlet to the air cleaner
case, and then tighten the clamp.
Torque: 3.0 N*m (31 kgf*cm, 27 in.*lbf)
EC
A086911E01
4.
INSTALL ENGINE ROOM NO. 2 RELAY BLOCK
(a) Install the relay block with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 8.4 N*m (86 kgf*cm, 74 in.*lbf)
5.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL (See page CH-7)
6.
INSTALL REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
7.
INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-8)
8.
INSTALL REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
A087418E02
EC–30
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – CANISTER PRESSURE SWITCHING VALVE
CANISTER PRESSURE SWITCHING VALVE
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
PURGE LINE HOSE
PRESSURE SWITCHING
VALVE CONNECTOR
PURGE LINE HOSE
EC
PURGE LINE HOSE
PRESSURE SWITCHING VALVE
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
2.9 (30, 26 in.*lbf)
A128664E01
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – CANISTER PRESSURE SWITCHING VALVE
EC–31
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
2.
REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-4)
3.
REMOVE REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
4.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
5.
REMOVE PRESSURE SWITCHING VALVE
(a) Disconnect the pressure switching valve connector.
(b) Disconnect the 3 canister hoses from the pressure
switching valve.
A087519E01
(c) Remove the bolt, then remove the pressure
switching valve.
A087520E01
EC
EC–32
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – CANISTER PRESSURE SWITCHING VALVE
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT PRESSURE SWITCHING VALVE
(a) Inspect the resistance.
(1) Measure the resistance between the terminals.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1-2
36 to 42 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
1 - Valve body
10 kΩ or higher
2 - Valve body
10 kΩ or higher
If the result is not as specified, replace the
pressure switching valve.
EC
Body
A132955E01
(b) Check the ventilation.
(1) Check that there is no ventilation from port E to
port F.
If there is ventilation, replace the pressure
switching valve.
Air
F
E
A087464E01
(2) Apply battery voltage across the terminals.
(3) Check that there is ventilation from port F when
air is applied to port G.
If there is no ventilation, replace the pressure
switching valve.
F
G
Battery
Air
A087465E01
INSTALLATION
1.
A087520E01
INSTALL PRESSURE SWITCHING VALVE
(a) Install the pressure switching valve with the bolt.
Torque: 2.9 N*m (30 kgf*cm, 26 in.*lbf)
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – CANISTER PRESSURE SWITCHING VALVE
EC–33
(b) Connect the 3 canister hoses to the pressure
switching valve.
(c) Connect the pressure switching valve.
2.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL (See page CH-7)
3.
INSTALL REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
4.
INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-8)
5.
INSTALL REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
6.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
A087519E01
EC
EC–34
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – FUEL TANK PRESSURE SENSOR
FUEL TANK PRESSURE SENSOR
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
LOWER CENTER INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL
x2
CLIP
CLIP
EC
POWER OUTLET CONNECTOR
GASKET
FRONT FLOOR CARPET
COMPRESSION SPRING
FRONT EXHAUST PIPE
43 (440, 32)
x2
GASKET
x2
43 (440, 32)
x4
COMPRESSION SPRING
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
30 (302, 22)
FRONT FLOOR PANEL BRACE
Non-reusable part
A131462E03
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – FUEL TANK PRESSURE SENSOR
EC–35
REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY
REAR FLOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER
FUEL TANK INLET PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY
EC
WIRE TO WIRE CONNECTOR
FUEL TUBE CONNECTOR
FUEL PUMP CONNECTOR
FUEL FILLER PIPE CLAMP
NO. 1 FUEL TANK BAND
SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
FUEL TANK SUB-ASSEMBLY
NO. 1 FUEL TANK BAND
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
x2
39 (400, 29)
x2
39 (400, 29)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A131463E03
EC–36
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – FUEL TANK PRESSURE SENSOR
FUEL TANK PRESSURE SENSOR
EC
TUBE JOINT CLIP
FUEL TANK RETAINER LH
FUEL TANK BREATHER
TUBE GASKET
Non-reusable part
A128661E01
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – FUEL TANK PRESSURE SENSOR
EC–37
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
CHECK FUEL TANK PRESSURE SENSOR
(a) Inspect the voltage.
(1) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(2) Measure the voltage between the terminals.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1-3
4.5 to 5.5 V
A088404E02
(3) Remove the fuel tank cap.
(4) Measure the voltage between the terminals.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
2-3
3.0 to 3.6 V
(5) Reinstall the fuel tank cap.
(6) Turn the power switch OFF.
EC
A088235E02
EC–38
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – FUEL TANK PRESSURE SENSOR
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
2.
REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-4)
3.
REMOVE REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
4.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
5.
REMOVE LOWER CENTER INSTRUMENT PANEL
FINISH PANEL (See page IP-18)
6.
REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY (See
page SE-15)
7.
REMOVE REAR FLOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER (See
page FU-23)
8.
REMOVE FRONT FLOOR PANEL BRACE (See page
EX-2)
9.
REMOVE FRONT EXHAUST PIPE (See page EC-9)
EC
10. REMOVE FUEL TANK SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page
FU-23)
11. REMOVE FUEL TANK PRESSURE SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the fuel tank pressure sensor connector.
A088377E01
(b) Remove the tube joint clip, then pull out the fuel tank
pressure sensor from the fuel tank retainer.
Pull Out
Tube Joint Clip
A087499E01
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – FUEL TANK PRESSURE SENSOR
EC–39
NOTICE:
• Remove dirt or foreign objects on fuel tank
pressure sensor before this work.
• Do not allow any scratches or foreign objects
on the parts when disconnecting as the fuel
tank pressure sensor has the O-ring that
seals the plug.
• Perform this work by hand. Do not use any
tools.
Tube Joint Clip
O-Ring
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor
A089469E02
INSTALLATION
Push
1.
Tube Joint Clip
A087518E01
INSTALL FUEL TANK PRESSURE SENSOR
(a) Push the fuel tank pressure sensor to the plug of the
fuel tank retainer, then install the tube joint clip.
NOTICE:
• Check that there are no scratches or foreign
objects around the connected part of the fuel
tank pressure sensor and fuel tank retainer
before this work.
• Check that the fuel tank pressure sensor is
securely inserted to the end.
• Check that the tube joint clip is on the collar
of the fuel tank pressure sensor.
• After installing the tube joint clip, check that
the fuel tank pressure sensor cannot be
pulled out.
(b) Connect the fuel tank pressure sensor connector.
2.
INSTALL FUEL TANK SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page FU35)
3.
INSTALL FRONT EXHAUST PIPE (See page EC-12)
4.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL (See page CH-7)
5.
CHECK FOR FUEL LEAKS (See page FU-8)
6.
CHECK FOR EXHAUST GAS LEAKS (See page EX-4)
7.
INSTALL FRONT FLOOR PANEL BRACE (See page
EX-4)
8.
INSTALL REAR FLOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER (See
page FU-38)
9.
INSTALL REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY (See
page SE-23)
10. INSTALL LOWER CENTER INSTRUMENT PANEL
FINNISH PANEL (See page IP-21)
11. INSTALL REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
12. INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-8)
13. INSTALL REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
EC
EC–40
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – FUEL TANK PRESSURE SENSOR
14. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
EC
EC–40
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
Clip
x6
RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
EC
ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
x3
x2
ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
x3 x2
x4
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A116928E02
EC–41
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
FRONT WIPER ARM RH
FRONT WIPER ARM COVER
FRONT WIPER ARM LH
21 (214, 15)
21 (214, 15)
x2
HOOD TO COWL TOP SEAL
CLIP
EC
COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER RH
COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER LH
CLIP
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
x5
WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR CONNECTOR
WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR
AND LINK ASSEMBLY
6.4 (65, 57 in.*lbf)
ENGINE ROOM NO. 2
RELAY BLOCK
x2
8.4 (86, 74 in.*lbf)
FRONT COWL TOP PANEL OUTER
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A124444E08
EC–42
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
x 12
11 (112, 8.1)
INVERTER COVER
11 (112, 8.1)
NO. 2 INVERTER COOLING HOSE
EC
NO. 1 INVERTER
COOLING HOSE
ENGINE ROOM MAIN
WIRE HARNESS
NO. 1 CIRCUIT BREAKER SENSOR
CONNECTOR
NO. 6 INVERTER COOLING HOSE
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A124445E03
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
EC–43
21 (214, 16)
21 (214, 16)
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
EC
21 (214, 16)
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
MG2 POWER CABLE
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
CONVERTER WITH
INVERTER ASSEMBLY
MG1 POWER CABLE
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A124446E04
EC–44
EC
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
AIR FUEL RATIO
SENSOR CONNECTOR
WIRE HARNESS CLAMP
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
44 (449, 32)*1
40 (408, 30)*2
AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
(for Bank 1 Sensor 1)
*1: For use with SST
*2: For use without SST
A128669E01
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
EC–45
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
E5
1.
A088403E02
Intelligent Tester
DLC3
A087542E01
Keep the Engine Speed
Lean
Airfuel
14.7 Ratio
3.3 V
Rich
Time
A086385E02
CHECK AIR FUEL RATIO COMPENSATION SYSTEM
(a) Inspect the voltage.
(1) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(2) Using a voltmeter, measure the voltage
between the ECM terminals.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E5-23 (A1A+) - E5-28 (E1)
3.0 to 3.6 V
E5-22 (A1A-) - E5-28 (E1)
2.7 to 3.3 V
NOTICE:
Connect the test leads from the backside of
the connector with the ECM connector
connected.
HINT:
The voltage between the ECM terminals is
constant regardless of the output voltage of the
air-fuel ratio sensor.
If the result is not as specified, check the airfuel ratio sensor and wire harness.
(b) Check the output waveform.
(1) Set the vehicle to inspection mode (see page
IN-34).
(2) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(3) Turn the power switch ON (READY).
(4) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(5) Select the item: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY / AFS B1 S1.
(6) Warm up the air fuel ratio sensor for
approximately 2 minutes at 2,500 rpm of the
engine speed.
(7) Maintain the engine speed at 2,500 rpm, then
check that the waveform of "AFS B1 S1" is
output as illustrated.
HINT:
• The waveform of illustration is a sample.
• Only the intelligent tester shows the
waveform of the air fuel ratio sensor.
(8) Check that "O2S B1 S2" fluctuates between 0
and 1 V with the engine speed at 2,500 rpm.
EC
EC–46
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
REMOVAL
EC
1.
PRECAUTION
CAUTION:
The hybrid system uses high voltage circuits, so
improper handling could cause an electric shock or
leakage. During service (e.g. installing or removing
the parts, inspection, replacing the parts), be sure to
follow the procedures (see page HV-519).
2.
REMOVE RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
(See page ED-2)
3.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
4.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
5.
DRAIN HV COOLANT (See page HX-58)
6.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
7.
REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-4)
8.
REMOVE REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
9.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
10. REMOVE SERVICE PLUG GRIP (See page HB-154)
11. REMOVE FRONT WIPER ARM COVER
12. REMOVE FRONT WIPER ARM LH (See page WW-13)
13. REMOVE FRONT WIPER ARM RH (See page WW-13)
14. REMOVE HOOD TO COWL TOP SEAL (See page
WW-13)
15. REMOVE COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER LH (See
page WW-13)
16. REMOVE COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER RH (See
page WW-13)
17. REMOVE WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR AND LINK
ASSEMBLY (See page WW-13)
18. REMOVE FRONT COWL TOP PANEL OUTER (See
page FU-12)
19. REMOVE INVERTER COVER (See page HV-531)
20. VERIFY THAT VOLTAGE OF INVERTER WITH
CONVERTER IS 0 V (See page HV-532)
21. DISCONNECT NO. 2 INVERTER COOLING HOSE
(See page HV-532)
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
EC–47
22. DISCONNECT NO. 1 INVERTER COOLING HOSE
(See page HV-532)
23. DISCONNECT NO. 6 INVERTER COOLING HOSE
(See page HV-533)
24. DISCONNECT NO. 1 CIRCUIT BREAKER SENSOR
(See page HV-533)
25. DISCONNECT FRAME WIRE (See page HV-533)
26. REMOVE CONVERTER WITH INVERTER ASSEMBLY
(See page HV-533)
27. REMOVE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR (for Bank 1
Sensor 1)
(a) Remove the wire harness clamp from the air fuel
ratio sensor.
(b) Disconnect the air fuel ratio sensor connector.
(c) Using SST, remove the air fuel ratio sensor.
SST 09224-00010
SST
A087473E01
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
(a) Measure the resistance between the terminals.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1 (HT) - 2 (+B)
1.8 to 3.4 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
2 (+B) - 4 (AF-)
10 kΩ or higher
If the result is not as specified, replace the sensor.
A087458E02
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR (for Bank 1
Sensor 1)
(a) Using SST, install the sensor.
SST 09224-00010
Torque: 44 N*m (449 kgf*cm, 32 in.*lbf) for use
with SST
40 N*m (408 kgf*cm, 30 ft.*lbf) for use
without SST
HINT:
Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of 30 cm
(11.81 in.).
(b) Connect the sensor connector.
(c) Install the wire harness clamp to the sensor.
2.
INSTALL CONVERTER WITH INVERTER ASSEMBLY
(See page HV-536)
3.
CONNECT FRAME WIRE (See page HV-537)
4.
CONNECT NO. 1 CIRCUIT BREAKER SENSOR (See
page HV-537)
5.
CONNECT NO. 6 INVERTER COOLING HOSE
SST
A087473E01
EC
EC–48
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
6.
CONNECT NO. 1 INVERTER COOLING HOSE
7.
CONNECT NO. 2 INVERTER COOLING HOSE
8.
INSTALL INVERTER COVER (See page HV-538)
9.
INSTALL FRONT COWL TOP PANEL OUTER (See
page FU-19)
10. INSTALL WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR AND LINK
ASSEMBLY (See page WW-16)
11. INSTALL COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER RH
12. INSTALL COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER LH
13. INSTALL HOOD TO COWL TOP SEAL
14. INSTALL FRONT WIPER ARM LH (See page WW-16)
15. INSTALL FRONT WIPER ARM RH (See page WW-16)
16. INSTALL FRONT WIPER ARM COVER
EC
17. INSTALL REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
18. INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-8)
19. INSTALL REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
20. INSTALL SERVICE PLUG GRIP (See page HB-154)
21. CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL (See page CH-7)
22. ADD HV COOLANT (See page HX-58)
23. CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKAGE (See
page HX-59)
24. INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
25. INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
26. INSTALL RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
(See page CO-9)
27. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
EC–49
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
LOWER CENTER INSTRUMENT
PANEL FINISH PANEL
x2
EC
POWER OUTLET CONNECTOR
FRONT FLOOR CARPET
44 (449, 32)*1
40 (408, 30)*2
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
(for Bank 1 Sensor 2)
WIRE HARNESS BRACKET
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
*1: For use with SST
*2: For use without SST
A131460E01
EC–50
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
REMOVAL
EC
1.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
2.
REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-4)
3.
REMOVE REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
4.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
5.
REMOVE LOWER CENTER INSTRUMENT PANEL
FINISH PANEL (See page IP-18)
6.
REMOVE HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (for Bank 1
Sensor 2)
(a) Using a clip remover, remove the clip.
(b) Fold back the floor carpet front.
A087436E01
(c) Disconnect the sensor connector.
(d) Remove the grommet of the sensor from the
vehicle.
A087437E01
(e) Remove the wire harness clamp bracket from the
sensor.
(f) Using SST, remove the sensor.
SST 09224-00010
SST
A087474E01
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
EC–51
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
(a) Measure the resistance between the terminals.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1 (HT) - 2 (+B)
11 to 16 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
1 (HT) - 4 (E)
10 kΩ or higher
If the result is not as specified, replace the sensor.
A087459E03
INSTALLATION
1.
SST
A087474E01
INSTALL HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (for Bank 1
Sensor 2)
(a) Using SST, install the sensor.
SST 09224-00010
Torque: 44 N*m (449 kgf*cm, 32 in.*lbf) for use
with SST
40 N*m (408 kgf*cm, 30 ft.*lbf) for use
without SST
HINT:
Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of 30 cm
(11.81 in.).
(b) Install the wire harness clamp bracket to the sensor.
(c) Install the grommet of the sensor to the vehicle.
(d) Connect the sensor connector.
(e) Install the floor carpet front with the clip.
2.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL (See page CH-7)
3.
CHECK FOR EXHAUST GAS LEAKS (See page EX-4)
4.
INSTALL LOWER CENTER INSTRUMENT PANEL
FINISH PANEL (See page IP-21)
5.
INSTALL REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
6.
INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-8)
7.
INSTALL REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
8.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
EC
EC–52
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL – FUEL TANK CAP
FUEL TANK CAP
INSPECTION
1.
Gasket
A091723E01
EC
INSPECT FUEL TANK CAP
(a) Check the appearance.
(1) Check that there is no deformation or damage
on the fuel tank cap and gasket.
If there are any defects, replace the fuel tank
cap.
ED–1
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – HOOD
HOOD
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR
BODY
COMPONENTS
HOOD SUB-ASSEMBLY
RADIATOR SUPPORT
SEAL
HOOD INSULATOR
x6
HOOD SUPPORT ROD
x8
x6
HINGE
13 (135, 10)
RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
HINGE
13 (135, 10)
HOOD LOCK CONTROL
LEVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
ED
HOOD LOCK ASSEMBLY
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
HOOD LOCK CONTROL CABLE ASSEMBLY
B126527E01
ED–2
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – HOOD
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT HOOD SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Check that the clearance measurements of areas A
to D are within the standard range.
B
C*
A
D
*: For the area C, check the height difference between the front fender panel and hood.
B075129E01
Standard measurement
Area
Specified Condition
Area
Specified Condition
A
4.3 +-1.5 mm (0.146 +-0.059 in.)
C
0.0 +-1.5 mm (0.000 +-0.059 in.)
B
3.7 +-1.5 mm (0.146 +-0.059 in.)
D
3.3 +-1.5 mm (0.130 +-0.059 in.)
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
(a) Remove the 6 clips and radiator support opening
cover.
2.
REMOVE HOOD LOCK ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 3 bolts and hood lock.
(b) Disconnect the lock control cable.
3.
REMOVE HOOD SUPPORT ROD
(a) Remove the rod.
(b) Using a clip remover, remove the holder and
retainer.
4.
REMOVE HOOD INSULATOR
(a) Using a clip remover, remove the 6 clips and
insulator.
ED
B075132E02
B076899E01
ED–3
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – HOOD
5.
REMOVE HOOD LOCK CONTROL CABLE
ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the front bumper cover (see page ET-3).
(b) Remove the front fender liner (see page ET-3).
(c) Using a screwdriver, disconnect the cable clamps
as shown in the illustration.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
C
D
Hood Lock
Control Lever
Sub-assembly
Cable
Cable
E
B
Hood Lock
Control Cable
F
E
Cable
Cable
A
A
F
B
C
D
Cable
Cable
B075134E02
(d) Remove the cable.
ED
ED–4
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – HOOD
ADJUSTMENT
Centering Bolt
Standard Bolt
HINT:
• Use the same procedure for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
• Centering bolts are used to mount the hood hinge and
hood lock. The hood and hood lock cannot be adjusted
with the centering bolts on. Substitute the centering bolts
with standard bolts (with washers) when making
adjustments.
• A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the
standard bolt chart (see page SS-2).
B057104E06
1.
ADJUST HOOD SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Adjust the hood's position.
(1) Loosen the 4 hinge bolts on the hood side.
B075133E01
A
Aligned
(2) Move the hood and adjust the clearance
between the hood and front fender. Make sure
that the clearance is within the standard range.
Standard measurement (A):
3.7 +-1.5 mm (0.146 +-0.059 in.)
(3) Tighten the hood's hinge bolts after the
adjustment.
Torque: 13 N*m (133 kgf*cm, 10 ft.*lbf)
B075130E01
(b) Adjust the cushion rubber so that the height of the
hood and the fender are aligned.
HINT:
Raise or lower the cushion rubber by turning it.
Standard measurement:
3.3 +-1.5 mm (0.130 +-0.059 in.)
ED
B076116E01
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – HOOD
ED–5
(c) Adjust the hood lock.
(1) Remove the 6 clips and radiator support
opening cover.
B075132E02
(2) Loosen the 3 bolts.
(3) Adjust the hood lock position so that the striker
can enter it smoothly.
(4) Tighten the bolts and nut after the adjustment.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
B075131E01
ED
ED–6
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – HOOD
INSTALLATION
HINT:
A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the standard
bolt chart (see page SS-2).
1.
INSTALL HOOD LOCK CONTROL CABLE
ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the cable.
(b) Connect the cable clamps as shown in the
illustration.
C
D
Hood Lock
Control Lever
Sub-assembly
Cable
Cable
E
B
Hood Lock
Control Cable
F
E
Cable
Cable
A
A
F
B
C
D
Cable
Cable
B075134E01
(c) Install the front fender liner (see page ET-6).
(d) Remove the front bumper cover (see page ET-6).
2.
INSTALL HOOD INSULATOR
(a) Install the insulator with the 6 clips.
3.
INSTALL HOOD SUPPORT ROD
(a) Install the retainer and holder.
(b) Install the rod.
4.
INSTALL HOOD LOCK ASSEMBLY
(a) Connect the hood lock control cable.
(b) Install the lock with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
(c) Adjust the hood lock (see page ED-3).
ED
B076899E01
ED–6
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – FRONT DOOR
FRONT DOOR
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR
BODY
COMPONENTS
FRONT DOOR TRIM BOARD
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
FRONT DOOR INSIDE HANDLE
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
FRONT NO. 1 SPEAKER
ASSEMBLY
DOOR PULL HANDLE
RIVET
FRONT NO. 2 SPEAKER ASSEMBLY
FRONT DOOR INSIDE
HANDLE BEZEL LH
DOOR FRAME GARNISH LH
FRONT DOOR TRIM BRACKET
FRONT DOOR ARMREST
UPPER BASE PANEL LH
ED
for RH Side
WINDOW REGULATOR
MASTER SWITCH
OUTER MIRROR
SWITCH ASSEMBLY
FRONT DOOR ARMREST
UPPER BASE PANEL RH
DOOR CONTROL
SWITCH ASSEMBLY
POWER WINDOW REGULATOR SWITCH
Non-reusable part
B126529E01
ED–7
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – FRONT DOOR
FRONT DOOR OUTSIDE HANDLE LH
FRONT DOOR WINDOW
FRAME MOULDING REAR LH
FRONT DOOR OUTSIDE
HANDLE COVER LH
OUTSIDE HANDLE REAR PAD
OUTSIDE HANDLE FRONT PAD
FRONT DOOR LOCK
ASSEMBLY LH
w/ Smart Key System
FRONT DOOR OUTSIDE HANDLE LH
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
FRONT DOOR FRONT
LOWER FRAME RETAINER
FRONT DOOR OUTSIDE HANDLE
FRAME SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
FRONT DOOR LOCK REINFORCEMENT
SUB-ASSEMBLY
ED
FRONT DOOR ECU
ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Precoated part
B126530E01
ED–8
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – FRONT DOOR
FRONT DOOR GLASS RUN
DOOR FRAME GARNISH LH
FRONT DOOR GLASS SUB-ASSEMBLY
FRONT DOOR WINDOW REGULATOR
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
FRONT POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
MOTOR ASSEMBLY LH
FRONT DOOR WEATHERSTRIP LH
ED
FRONT DOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B126531E01
ED–9
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – FRONT DOOR
OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSEMBLY LH
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
FRONT DOOR BELT MOULDING ASSEMBLY LH
8.5 (87, 75 in.*lbf)
8.5 (87, 75 in.*lbf)
26 (265, 19)
26 (265, 19)
26 (265, 19)
8.5 (87, 75 in.*lbf)
FRONT DOOR REAR LOWER FRAME SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
FRONT DOOR NO. 2
SERVICE HOLE COVER
ED
FRONT DOOR NO. 1
STIFFENER CUSHION
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Precoated part
B126532E01
ED–10
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – FRONT DOOR
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT FRONT DOOR SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Check that the clearance measurements of areas A
to E are within the standard range.
200 mm (7.87 in.)*
B
D
C
A
E
*: 200 mm (7.87 in.) from the end of the window frame, check
the clearances B and C as illustrated in the cross section.
B075122E03
Standard measurement
ED
Area
Specified Condition
Area
Specified Condition
A
4.0 +-1.5 mm (0.157 +-0.059 in.)
D
4.0 +-1.5 mm (0.157 +-0.059 in.)
B
5.1 +-1.5 mm (0.201 +-0.059 in.)
E
5.7 +-1.5 mm (0.224 +-0.059 in.)
C
6.3 +-1.5 mm (0.248 +-0.059 in.)
-
-
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – FRONT DOOR
ED–11
DISASSEMBLY
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the LH side and RH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
REMOVE NO. 2 REAR FLOOR BOARD
2.
REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX
3.
REMOVE NO. 3 REAR FLOOR BOARD ASSEMBLY
4.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
5.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR LOWER FRAME BRACKET
GARNISH LH
(a) Using a screwdriver, detach the 2 clips and remove
the garnish.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
6.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR INSIDE HANDLE BEZEL LH
(a) Using a screwdriver, detach the 3 claws and remove
the bezel.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
7.
REMOVE DOOR PULL HANDLE
(a) Remove the screw and pull handle.
B075149E02
B076973E06
B075150E01
ED
ED–12
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – FRONT DOOR
8.
B075142E03
(d) Passenger's side:
Using a screwdriver, detach the 2 clips and 4 claws,
and remove the armrest base panel together with
the 2 switches.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(e) Disconnect the switch connector.
(f) Using a screwdriver, detach the 2 claws and remove
the door control switch.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(g) Using a screwdriver, detach the 2 claws and remove
the power window regulator switch.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
B075143E03
9.
Protective Tape Protective Tape
Screw
REMOVE FRONT DOOR ARMREST UPPER BASE
PANEL LH
(a) Driver's side:
Using a screwdriver, detach the 2 clips and 4 claws,
and remove the armrest base panel together with
the window regulator master switch.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Disconnect the switch connector.
(c) Remove the 3 screws and the window regulator
master switch from the armrest base panel.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR TRIM BOARD SUBASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the screw.
(b) Using a screwdriver, detach the 7 clips and remove
the trim board.
HINT:
• Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
• In order to prevent the door panel from being
damaged, use protective tape to cover the areas
indicated by the arrow marks in the illustration.
• If the clip cannot be reached with the
screwdriver, pull on the lower trim to remove it.
ED
B075137E02
Claw A
1
Claw
2
B077633E02
10. REMOVE FRONT DOOR INSIDE HANDLE SUBASSEMBLY LH
(a) Using a screwdriver, detach claw A as shown in the
illustration.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Move the inside handle in the direction indicated by
the arrow mark in the illustration. This will release
the 2 claws and allow removal of the inside handle.
(c) Disconnect the 2 cables from the inside handle.
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – FRONT DOOR
ED–13
11. REMOVE OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSEMBLY
LH
(a) Disconnect the mirror connector.
(b) Remove the 3 nuts and mirror.
NOTICE:
Be careful when removing the nuts as the mirror
may fall and become damaged.
B075148E01
12. REMOVE FRONT DOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER LH
(a) Remove the 2 screws and trim bracket.
(b) Remove the service hole cover.
NOTICE:
Remove the remaining tape on the door side.
(c) Remove the 3 screws and service hole cover No. 2.
B075139E01
B061431E01
13. REMOVE FRONT NO. 1 SPEAKER ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a drill of less than φ4 mm (0.16 in.), drill out
the 3 rivet heads and remove the speaker.
NOTICE:
• Be sure to gently place the drill perpendicular
to the rivet, otherwise the rivet hole and the
drill itself will be damaged.
• Be careful with the cut rivet, because it is hot.
(b) Even if the flange is taken off, continue drilling and
push out the remaining fragments using the drill.
(c) Using a vacuum cleaner, remove the drilled rivet
and dust from the inside of the door.
14. REMOVE FRONT DOOR BELT MOULDING
ASSEMBLY LH (See page ET-20)
15. REMOVE FRONT DOOR WINDOW FRAME
MOULDING REAR LH (See page ET-32)
16. REMOVE DOOR FRAME GARNISH LH
(a) Using a clip remover, detach the claws and remove
the garnish.
17. REMOVE FRONT DOOR GLASS SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
HINT:
Insert cushions inside the door panel to prevent the glass
from being scratched.
B075163E01
ED
ED–14
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – FRONT DOOR
B075147E01
(a) Driver's Side:
Connect the window regulator master switch.
(b) Passenger's side:
Connect the power window regulator switch.
(c) Move the door glass until the 2 bolts appear in the
service holes.
(d) Remove the 2 bolts.
NOTICE:
Be careful when removing the 2 bolts as the
glass may fall and become damaged.
(e) Remove the door glass in the direction indicated by
the arrow marks in the illustration.
(f) Driver's side:
Disconnect the window regulator master switch.
(g) Passenger side:
Disconnect the power window regulator switch.
2
1
B062423E07
18. REMOVE FRONT DOOR WINDOW REGULATOR
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the 6 bolts and regulator.
NOTICE:
Be careful when removing the bolts as the
window regulator may fall and become
damaged.
(c) Remove the glass ran.
B075146E01
19. REMOVE FRONT POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
MOTOR ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Using a T25 "torx" driver, remove the 3 screws and
motor.
ED
B070074E01
20. REMOVE FRONT DOOR REAR LOWER FRAME SUBASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the bolt and frame.
B075144E01
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – FRONT DOOR
ED–15
21. REMOVE FRONT DOOR OUTSIDE HANDLE COVER
LH
(a) Remove the hole plug.
(b) Using a T30 "torx" wrench, loosen the screw and
remove the cover with the door lock key cylinder
installed.
Hole Plug
B061438E08
1
2
B056613E05
22. REMOVE FRONT DOOR OUTSIDE HANDLE LH
(a) w/ Smart Key System:
Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the handle by sliding and pulling it in the
direction indicated by the arrow mark in the
illustration.
(c) Remove the outside handle pad front and rear.
NOTICE:
If the release plate is not pulled and held when
removing the handle, the release plate will
interfere with the handle and become damaged.
23. REMOVE FRONT DOOR LOCK ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Using a T30 "torx" wrench, remove the 3 screws
and door lock.
NOTICE:
Be careful when removing the screws as the
door lock may fall and become damaged.
HINT:
Remove the door lock through the service hole.
B066894E02
24. REMOVE FRONT DOOR OUTSIDE HANDLE FRAME
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the 2 screws and No. 1 stiffener cushion.
ED
B075145E01
(b) Using a T30 "torx" wrench, loosen the screw of the
frame.
Screw
B077632E03
ED–16
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – FRONT DOOR
(c) Using pliers, pinch the clip and remove the handle
frame, as shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
Be sure to remove the outside handle frame
together with the clips as the clips will be
damaged if they remain attached to the door
panel.
HINT:
Remove the frame through the service hole.
B057102E01
25. REMOVE FRONT DOOR CHECK ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the 3 bolts and door check.
HINT:
Remove the check through the service hole.
B061463E02
ED
26. REMOVE FRONT DOOR WEATHERSTRIP LH
(a) Using a clip remover, detach the clips and remove
the weatherstrip.
HINT:
If the clips are damaged during removal, replace
them.
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – FRONT DOOR
ED–17
ADJUSTMENT
HINT:
• Before adjusting the door position for vehicles equipped
with side airbags and curtain shield airbags, be sure to
disconnect the battery. After adjustment, inspect the SRS
warning light, the side airbag system and the curtain shield
airbag system for normal operation (see page RS-31).
Then initialize both systems (see page IN-32).
• Use the same procedure for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
• Centering bolts are used to mount the door hinge to the
vehicle body and door. The door cannot be adjusted with
the centering bolts on. Substitute the centering bolts with
standard bolts (w/ washers) when making adjustments.
1.
Centering Bolt
Standard Bolt
B057104E06
ADJUST FRONT DOOR SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery.
CAUTION:
Work must be started at least 90 seconds after
the power switch is turned OFF and the negative
(-) terminal cable is disconnected from the
battery. (The SRS is equipped with a back-up
power source. If work is started within 90
seconds of disconnecting the negative (-)
terminal battery and turning the power switch
OFF)
(b) Using SST, loosen the body side's hinge bolts and
adjust the door's position.
SST 09812-00010, 09812-00020
(c) Tighten the body side's hinge bolts after the
adjustment.
Torque: 26 N*m (265 kgf*cm, 19 ft.*lbf)
B075124E01
(d) Loosen the door side's hinge bolts and adjust the
door's position.
(e) Tighten the door side's hinge bolts after the
adjustment.
Torque: 26 N*m (265 kgf*cm, 19 ft.*lbf)
B075123E01
ED
ED–18
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – FRONT DOOR
(f)
B068038E01
ED
Using a T40 "torx" wrench, adjust the striker position
by slightly loosening the striker mounting screws
and hitting the striker with a plastic-faced hammer.
(g) Tighten the striker mounting screws after the
adjustment.
Torque: 23 N*m (235 kgf*cm, 17 ft.*lbf)
(h) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the
battery.
(i) Check which systems need to be initialized and
perform initialization (see page IN-32).
(j) Check the SRS warning light (see page RS-31).
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – FRONT DOOR
ED–19
REASSEMBLY
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
• A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the
standard bolt chart (see page SS-2).
1.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR WEATHERSTRIP LH
(a) Install the weatherstrip and attach the clips.
2.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR CHECK ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Apply MP grease to the sliding areas of the check.
(b) Install the check to the door panel with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 5.5 N*m (56 kgf*cm, 49 in.*lbf)
(c) Apply adhesive to the threads of the bolt.
Adhesive:
Toyota Genuine Adhesive 1324, Three Bond
1324 or Equivalent
(d) Install the check to the body panel with the bolt.
Torque: 4.0 N*m (41 kgf*cm, 35 in.*lbf)
3.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR OUTSIDE HANDLE PAD
REAR
(a) Attach the 2 claws to install the pad.
4.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR OUTSIDE HANDLE PAD
FRONT
(a) Attach the 2 claws to install the pad.
Adhesive
B061463E05
B083064E01
ED
B084266E01
5.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR OUTSIDE HANDLE FRAME
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the outside handle link.
(b) Apply MP grease to the sliding areas of the frame.
(c) Using a T30 "torx" socket wrench, install the frame
with the screw.
Torque: 4.0 N*m (41 kgf*cm, 35 in.*lbf)
(d) Install the No. 1 stiffener cushion with the 2 screws.
6.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR LOCK ASSEMBLY
(a) Apply MP grease to the sliding and rotating areas of
the door lock.
Screw
B077632E03
ED–20
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – FRONT DOOR
(b) Install new door lock wire harness packing.
NOTICE:
• When reinstalling the door lock, always use
new packing.
• Do not allow grease or dirt to contaminate the
gap between the door panel and packing.
• Old packing or damaged packing cannot
effectively protect against water, which can
damage the door lock.
(c) Insert the control rod into the door lock, and then set
it to the door panel.
NOTICE:
Make sure that the rod is securely engaged with
the lock.
Rod
B065961E02
(d) Apply adhesive to the threads of the 3 screws.
Adhesive:
Toyota Genuine 1324, Three Bond 1324 or
Equivalent
(e) Using a T30 "torx" wrench, install the door lock with
the 3 screws.
Torque: 5.0 N*m (51 kgf*cm, 44 in.*lbf)
(f) Connect the door lock connector.
7.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR OUTSIDE HANDLE LH
8.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR OUTSIDE HANDLE COVER
LH
(a) Using a T30 "torx" wrench, install the cover (with the
door lock key cylinder installed) with the screw.
Torque: 4.0 N*m (41 kgf*cm, 37 in.*lbf)
(b) Install the hole plug.
9.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR FRAME SUB-ASSEMBLY
REAR LOWER LH
(a) Install the frame with the bolt.
Torque: 6.2 N*m (63 kgf*cm, 55 in.*lbf)
B066894E02
ED
Hole Plug
B061438E11
B075144E01
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – FRONT DOOR
ED–21
10. INSTALL FRONT POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
MOTOR ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Using a T25 "torx" driver, install the motor with the 3
screws.
Torque: 5.4 N*m (55 kgf*cm, 48 in.*lbf)
B070074E01
11. INSTALL FRONT DOOR WINDOW REGULATOR SUBASSEMBLY LH
(a) Apply MP grease to the sliding and rotating areas of
the window regulator.
NOTICE:
Do not apply grease to the spring of the window
regulator.
B075151E02
Bolt A
B077024E01
(b) Loosely install the bolt labeled A onto the window
regulator.
(c) Insert the window regulator into the door panel. Use
the bolt labeled A to hand the window regulator on
the door panel.
(d) Install the window regulator with the 5 bolts and
tighten the bolt labeled A.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Be careful not to drop the window regulator as it
may become damaged.
(e) Connect the window regulator connector.
12. INSTALL FRONT DOOR GLASS SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the glass run.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the glass.
(b) Insert the door glass into the door panel along the
glass run as indicated by the arrow marks in the
illustration.
1
2
B062423E04
ED
ED–22
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – FRONT DOOR
(c) Install the door glass to the window regulator with
the 2 bolts.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
13. INSTALL DOOR FRAME GARNISH LH
(a) Attach the claws to install the garnish.
14. INSTALL FRONT DOOR WINDOW FRAME
MOULDING REAR LH (See page ET-32)
B075147E01
15. INSTALL FRONT DOOR BELT MOULDING
ASSEMBLY LH (See page ET-21)
16. INSTALL FRONT NO. 1 SPEAKER ASSEMBLY (See
page AV-188)
B075138E01
17. INSTALL FRONT DOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER LH
(a) Install the No. 2 service hole cover with the 3
screws.
(b) Apply butyl tape to the door as shown in the
illustration.
(c) Install a new service hole cover.
HINT:
• When installing the service hole cover, pull out
the links and connectors through the service hole
cover.
• There should be no wrinkles or folds after
attaching the service hole cover.
• After attaching the service hole cover, check the
quality of the seal.
(d) Install the trim bracket with the 2 screws.
18. INSTALL OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSEMBLY
LH
(a) Install the mirror with the 3 nuts.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
(b) Connect the mirror connector.
B075148E01
ED
19. INSTALL FRONT DOOR INSIDE HANDLE SUBASSEMBLY LH
(a) Move the inside handle in the direction indicated by
the arrow in the illustration to install the inside
handle.
(b) Connect the 2 cables to the inside handle.
Claw
B068930E17
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – FRONT DOOR
Protective Tape Protective Tape
Screw
ED–23
20. INSTALL FRONT DOOR TRIM BOARD SUBASSEMBLY LH
(a) Attach the 7 clips to install the trim board.
(b) Install the screw.
21. INSTALL FRONT ARMREST BASE PANEL UPPER LH
(a) for Driver's Side:
Install the window regulator master switch to the
armrest upper base panel with the 3 screws.
(b) Connect the switch connector.
B075137E02
(c) Attach the 2 clips and 4 claws to install the armrest
base panel (with the window regulator master
switch).
(d) for Passenger's Side:
Attach the 2 claws to install the power window
regulator switch.
(e) Attach the 2 claws to install the door control switch.
(f) Connect the connector.
B075142E03
(g) Attach the 2 clips and 4 claws to install the armrest
upper base panel together with the 2 switches.
B075143E03
22. INSTALL DOOR PULL HANDLE
(a) Install the pull handle with the screw.
B075150E01
ED
ED–24
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – FRONT DOOR
23. INSTALL FRONT DOOR INSIDE HANDLE BEZEL LH
(a) Attach the 3 claws to install the bezel.
B076973E07
24. INSTALL FRONT DOOR LOWER FRAME BRACKET
GARNISH LH
(a) Attach the 2 clips to install the garnish.
25. CONNECT CABLE TO BATTERY NEGATIVE
TERMINAL
26. INSTALL NO. 3 REAR FLOOR BOARD
27. INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX
B075149E02
28. INSTALL NO. 2 REAR FLOOR BOARD
29. INSPECT SRS WARNING LIGHT
(a) Inspect the SRS warning light (see page RS-31).
30. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
ED
ED–23
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – REAR DOOR
REAR DOOR
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR
BODY
COMPONENTS
RIVET
REAR DOOR INSIDE HANDLE
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
REAR DOOR INSIDE HANDLE BEZEL LH
DOOR PULL HANDLE
REAR SPEAKER ASSEMBLY
REAR NO. 2 SPEAKER
ASSEMBLY
REAR DOOR TRIM BOARD
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
REAR DOOR TRIM NO. 2
BRACKET
ED
REAR DOOR ARMREST UPPER BASE PANEL LH
POWER WINDOW REGULATOR SWITCH
Non-reusable part
B126533E02
ED–24
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – REAR DOOR
REAR DOOR OUTSIDE HANDLE COVER LH
OUTSIDE HANDLE
REAR PAD
REAR DOOR OUTSIDE
HANDLE ASSEMBLY LH
OUTSIDE HANDLE
FRONT PAD
REAR DOOR LOCK
ASSEMBLY LH
REAR DOOR WINDOW FRAME
FRONT MOULDING LH
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
REAR DOOR OUTSIDE HANDLE
FRAME SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
REAR DOOR ECU
ED
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Precoated part
B126534E01
ED–25
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – REAR DOOR
REAR DOOR GLASS RUN
REAR DOOR GLASS SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
REAR DOOR WINDOW REGULATOR
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
DOOR FRAME GARNISH
REAR DOOR WEATHERSTRIP LH
POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
MOTOR ASSEMBLY LH
ED
REAR DOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
B126535E01
ED–26
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – REAR DOOR
REAR DOOR REAR GUIDE SEAL
REAR DOOR WINDOW REAR
GUIDE SUB-ASSEMBLY
REAR DOOR BELT
MOULDING ASSEMBLY LH
REAR DOOR UPPER
HINGE ASSEMBLY LH
26 (265, 19)
26 (265, 19)
26 (265, 19)
8.5 (87, 75 in.*lbf)
26 (265, 19)
ED
REAR DOOR CHECK
ASSEMBLY LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
REAR DOOR LOWER
HINGE ASSEMBLY LH
Precoated part
B126536E01
ED–27
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – REAR DOOR
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT REAR DOOR SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Check that the clearance measurements of areas A
to E are within the standard range.
200 mm (7.94 in.)*
B
D
C
A
E
E
F
*: 200 mm (7.94 in.) from the end of the window frame, check
the clearances B and C as illustrated in the cross section.
B075125E02
Standard measurement
Area
Specified Condition
Area
Specified Condition
A
4.0 +-1.5 mm (0.157 +-0.059 in.)
D
4.0 +-1.5 mm (0.157 +-0.059 in.)
B
5.2 +-1.5 mm (0.205 +-0.059 in.)
E
5.7 +-1.5 mm (0.224 +-0.059 in.)
C
6.6 +-1.5 mm (0.260 +-0.059 in.)
-
-
ED
ED–28
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – REAR DOOR
DISASSEMBLY
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
REMOVE NO. 2 REAR FLOOR BOARD
2.
REMOVE REAR FLOOR DECK BOX
3.
REMOVE NO. 3 REAR FLOOR BOARD ASSEMBLY
4.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
5.
REMOVE REAR DOOR INSIDE HANDLE BEZEL LH
(a) Using a screwdriver, detach the 3 claws and remove
the bezel.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
6.
REMOVE DOOR PULL HANDLE
(a) Remove the screw and pull handle.
7.
REMOVE REAR DOOR ARMREST UPPER BASE
PANEL LH
(a) Using a screwdriver, detach the 2 claws and remove
the power window regulator switch.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Disconnect the switch connector.
B076973E06
B075150E01
ED
B075153E03
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – REAR DOOR
ED–29
8.
REMOVE REAR DOOR TRIM BOARD SUBASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the screw.
(b) Using a screwdriver, detach the 7 clips and remove
the trim board.
HINT:
• In order to prevent the door panel from being
damaged, use protective tape to cover the areas
indicated by the arrow marks in the illustration.
• If the clip cannot be reached with the
screwdriver, pull on the lower trim to remove it.
9.
REMOVE REAR DOOR INSIDE HANDLE SUBASSEMBLY LH
(a) Using a screwdriver, detach the claw labeled A as
shown in the illustration.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Move the inside handle in the direction indicated by
the arrow mark in the illustration. This will release
the 2 claws and allow removal of the inside handle.
(c) Disconnect the 2 cables from the inside handle.
Protective Tape
B075164E03
Claw A
1
Claw
2
B077633E02
10. REMOVE REAR SPEAKER ASSEMBLY (See page AV195)
11. REMOVE REAR DOOR BELT MOULDING ASSEMBLY
LH (See page ET-23)
12. REMOVE REAR DOOR WINDOW FRAME FRONT
MOULDING LH (See page ET-23)
13. REMOVE DOOR FRAME GARNISH LH
(a) Using a clip remover, detach the claws and remove
the garnish.
ED
B075162E01
ED–30
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – REAR DOOR
14. REMOVE REAR DOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER LH
(a) Remove the 2 screws and No. 2 bracket.
(b) Remove the service hole cover.
NOTICE:
Remove the remaining tape on the door side.
B075141E01
15. REMOVE REAR DOOR WINDOW REAR GUIDE SUBASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the 3 screws labeled A, bolt and window
guide rear together with the guide seal.
(b) Remove the screw labeled B and rear door guide
seal.
Screw B
Screw A
Bolt
B075155E01
16. REMOVE REAR DOOR GLASS SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
HINT:
Insert cushions inside the door panel to prevent the glass
from being scratched.
(a) Connect the power window regulator switch.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and glass.
NOTICE:
Be careful when removing the bolts as the glass
may fall and become damaged.
(c) Disconnect the power window regulator switch.
B075159E01
ED
B075160E01
17. REMOVE REAR DOOR WINDOW REGULATOR SUBASSEMBLY LH
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the 6 bolts and regulator.
NOTICE:
Be careful when removing the bolts as the
window regulator may fall and become
damaged.
HINT:
Remove the window regulator through the service
hole.
(c) Remove the glass ran.
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – REAR DOOR
ED–31
18. REMOVE POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR
ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Using a T25 "torx" driver, remove the 3 screws and
motor.
B070074E01
19. REMOVE REAR DOOR LOCK ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Using a T30 "torx" wrench, remove the 3 screws
and door lock.
NOTICE:
Be careful when removing the bolts as the door
lock may fall and become damaged.
HINT:
Remove the door lock through the service hole.
B075157E01
20. REMOVE REAR DOOR OUTSIDE HANDLE COVER
LH
(a) Using a T30 "torx" wrench, loosen the screw and
remove the outside handle cover.
B068777E01
21. REMOVE REAR DOOR OUTSIDE HANDLE
ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the handle by sliding and pulling it in the
direction indicated by the arrow mark in the
illustration.
ED
B075156E01
(b) Pushing and pulling the outside handle in the arrow
mark direction as shown in the illustration, remove
the outside handle.
NOTICE:
If the release plate is not pulled and held when
removing the outside handle, the release plate
will interfere with the outside handle and
become damaged.
(c) Remove the outside handle pad front and rear.
(1)
(2)
B056613E11
ED–32
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – REAR DOOR
22. REMOVE REAR DOOR OUTSIDE HANDLE FRAME
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Using a T30 "torx" wrench, loosen the screw.
(b) Slide the outside handle frame and remove it.
HINT:
Remove the door check through the service hole.
B075158E01
23. REMOVE REAR DOOR CHECK ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the 2 nuts, bolt and door check.
HINT:
Remove the door check through the service hole.
B062429E01
ED
24. REMOVE REAR DOOR WEATHERSTRIP LH
(a) Using a clip remover, detach the clip and remove
the weatherstrip.
HINT:
If the clips are damaged, replace them with new
clips.
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – REAR DOOR
ED–33
ADJUSTMENT
HINT:
• Before adjusting the door position for vehicles equipped
with the side airbags and curtain shield airbags, be sure to
disconnect the battery. After adjustment, inspect the SRS
warning light, the side airbag system and the curtain shield
airbag system for normal operation (see page RS-31).
Then initialize both systems (see page IN-32).
• Use the same procedure for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
• Centering bolts are used to mount the door hinge to the
vehicle body and door. The door cannot be adjusted with
the centering bolts on. Substitute the centering bolts with
standard bolts (w/ washers) when making adjustments.
1.
Centering Bolt
Standard Bolt
B057104E06
ADJUST REAR DOOR SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the negative (-) terminal cable from the
battery.
CAUTION:
Work must be started at least 90 seconds after
the power switch is turned OFF and the negative
(-) terminal cable is disconnected from the
battery. (The SRS is equipped with a back-up
power source. If work is started within 90
seconds of disconnecting the negative (-)
terminal battery and turning the power switch
OFF, the SRS may deploy.)
(b) Loosen the body side's hinge bolts and adjust the
door's position.
(c) Tighten the body side's hinge bolts after the
adjustment.
Torque: 26 N*m (265 kgf*cm, 19 ft.*lbf)
B075126E01
(d) Loosen the door side's hinge bolts and adjust the
door's position.
(e) Tighten the door side's hinge bolts after the
adjustment.
Torque: 26 N*m (265 kgf*cm, 19 ft.*lbf)
B075127E01
ED
ED–34
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – REAR DOOR
(f)
B055940E01
ED
Using a T40 "torx" wrench, adjust the striker position
by slightly loosing the striker mounting screws and
hitting the striker with a plastic-faced hammer.
(g) Tighten the striker mounting screws after the
adjustment.
Torque: 23 N*m (235 kgf*cm, 17 ft.*lbf)
(h) Connect the negative (-) terminal cable to the
battery.
(i) Check which systems need to be initialized and
perform initialization (see page IN-32).
(j) Check the SRS warning light (see page RS-31).
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – REAR DOOR
ED–35
REASSEMBLY
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the RH side and LH
side.
• A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the
standard bolt chart (see page SS-2).
1.
INSTALL REAR DOOR WEATHERSTRIP LH
(a) Install the weatherstrip and attach the clips.
2.
INSTALL REAR DOOR CHECK ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Apply MP grease to the sliding areas of the door
check.
(b) Install the door check to the door panel with the 2
nuts.
Torque: 5.5 N*m (56 kgf*cm, 49 in.*lbf)
(c) Apply adhesive to the bolt.
Adhesive:
Toyota Genuine Adhesive 1324, Three Bond
1324 or equivalent
(d) Install the door check to the body panel with the
bolt.
Torque: 30 N*m (306 kgf*cm, 22 ft.*lbf)
HINT:
Install the door check so that the rivet head is facing
up.
3.
INSTALL REAR DOOR OUTSIDE HANDLE FRAME
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Using a T30 "torx" wrench, install the handle frame
with the screw.
Torque: 7.0 N*m (56 kgf*cm, 49 in.*lbf)
4.
INSTALL REAR DOOR OUTSIDE HANDLE
ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the outside handle pad front and rear.
(b) Pull and hold the release plate of the outside handle
frame, as shown in the illustration.
B062429E01
B075158E01
B075156E01
ED
ED–36
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – REAR DOOR
(c) Install the handle by pushing it in the direction of the
arrow marks in the illustration.
NOTICE:
If the release plate is not pulled and held when
installing the outside handle, the release plate
will interfere with the outside handle and
become damaged.
(2)
(1)
B064044E02
B068777E01
5.
INSTALL REAR DOOR OUTSIDE HANDLE COVER
RH
(a) Using a T30 "torx" wrench, install the outside handle
handle cover with the screw.
Torque: 4.0 N*m (41 kgf*cm, 35 in.*lbf)
6.
INSTALL REAR DOOR LOCK ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Apply MP grease to the sliding and rotating areas of
the door lock.
(b) Install new door lock wire harness packing.
NOTICE:
• When reinstalling the door lock, always use
new packing.
• Do not allow grease or dirt to contaminate the
gap between the door panel and packing.
• Old packing or damaged packing cannot
effectively protect against water, which can
damage the door lock.
(c) Engage the lock with the release plate of the outside
handle, and then set it to the door panel.
NOTICE:
Make sure that the release plate of the outside
handle frame is securely engaged with the lock.
(d) Apply adhesive to the 3 screws.
Adhesive:
Toyota genuine adhesive 1324, THREE BOND
1324 or equivalent
(e) Using a T30 "torx" wrench, install the door lock with
the 3 screws.
Torque: 5.0 N*m (51 kgf*cm, 42 in.*lbf)
(f) Connect the door lock connector.
ED
B075157E01
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – REAR DOOR
ED–37
7.
INSTALL POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR
ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a T25 "torx" driver, install the motor with the 3
screws.
Torque: 5.4 N*m (55 kgf*cm, 48 in.*lbf)
8.
INSTALL REAR DOOR WINDOW REGULATOR SUBASSEMBLY LH
(a) Apply MP grease to the sliding and rotating areas of
the window regulator.
NOTICE:
Do not apply grease to the spring of the window
regulator.
B070074E01
B075154E01
(b) Loosely install the bolt labeled A onto the window
regulator.
(c) Insert the window regulator into the door panel. Use
the bolt labeled A to hang the window regulator on
the door panel.
(d) Install the window regulator with the 5 bolts and
tighten the bolt labeled A.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to drop the window regulator as it
may become damaged.
(e) Connect the window regulator connector.
Bolt A
B079700E01
9.
INSTALL REAR DOOR GLASS SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the glass run.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the glass.
(b) Install the door glass to the window regulator with
the 2 bolts.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
B075159E01
10. INSTALL REAR DOOR WINDOW REAR GUIDE SUBASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the window guide rear together with the rear
door guide seal.
B075155E02
ED
ED–38
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – REAR DOOR
Butyl Tape
B075140E03
11. INSTALL REAR DOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER LH
(a) Apply butyl tape to the door as shown in the
illustration.
(b) Install a new service hole cover.
HINT:
• When installing the service hole cover, pull out
the links and connectors through the service hole
cover.
• There should be no wrinkles or folds after
attaching the service hole cover.
• After attaching the service hole cover, check the
sealing quality.
(c) Install the trim bracket with the 2 screws.
12. INSTALL DOOR FRAME GARNISH LH
(a) Attach the claw to install the garnish.
13. INSTALL REAR DOOR WINDOW FRAME FRONT
MOULDING LH (See page ET-35)
14. INSTALL REAR DOOR BELT MOULDING ASSEMBLY
LH (See page ET-23)
15. INSTALL REAR SPEAKER ASSEMBLY (See page AV195)
B075162E03
16. INSTALL REAR DOOR INSIDE HANDLE SUBASSEMBLY LH
(a) Connect the 2 cables from the inside handle.
(b) Move the inside handle in the direction indicated by
the arrow in the illustration to install the inside
handle.
Claw
B068930E17
17. INSTALL REAR DOOR TRIM BOARD SUBASSEMBLY LH
(a) Attach the 7 clips and install the trim board.
(b) Install the screw.
Protective Tape
ED
B075164E03
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – REAR DOOR
ED–39
18. INSTALL REAR DOOR ARMREST UPPER BASE
PANEL LH
B075153E03
19. INSTALL DOOR PULL HANDLE
(a) Install the pull handle with the screw.
B075150E01
20. INSTALL REAR DOOR INSIDE HANDLE BEZEL LH
(a) Attach the 3 claws to install the bezel.
21. CONNECT CABLE TO BATTERY NEGATIVE
TERMINAL
22. INSTALL NO. 3 REAR FLOOR BOARD ASSEMBLY
23. INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX
24. INSTALL NO. 2 REAR FLOOR BOARD
B076973E07
25. INSPECT SRS WARNING LIGHT
(a) Inspect the SRS warning light (see page RS-31).
26. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
ED
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR
ED–39
BACK DOOR
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR
BODY
COMPONENTS
REAR SPOILER SUB-ASSEMBLY
BACK DOOR TRIM UPPER
PANEL ASSEMBLY
BACK DOOR SIDE GARNISH RH
w/ Smart Key System
BACK DOOR SIDE GARNISH LH
ED
BACK DOOR UPPER TRIM BOARD ASSEMBLY
BACK DOOR UPPER TRIM BOARD ASSEMBLY
B126537E01
ED–40
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR
DECK TRIM SIDE BOARD RH
FLOOR MAT
DECK TRIM SERVICE
HOLE COVER
DECK TRIM SIDE BOARD LH
DECK TRIM COVER REAR
BACK DOOR LOCK ASSEMBLY
7.5 (76, 75 in.*lbf)
DECK REAR FLOOR BOX
ED
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
BACK DOOR LOWER TRIM BOARD ASSEMBLY
B126538E01
ED–41
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR
BACK DOOR OUTSIDE
GARNISH SUB-ASSEMBLY
BACK DOOR LOCK
STRIKER ASSEMBLY
BACK DOOR OPENING
SWITCH ASSEMBLY
7.5 (235, 16 in.*lbf)
w/ Camera
TELEVISION CAMERA
ASSEMBLY
LICENSE PLATE LIGHT
ASSEMBLY
BACK DOOR LOCK
STRIKER COVER
w/ Smart Key System
ED
BACK DOOR OPENING
SWITCH ASSEMBLY
BACK DOOR OUTSIDE
GARNISH SUB-ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B126539E01
ED–42
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR
ARM AND BLADE ASSEMBLY
REAR WIPER MOTOR ASSEMBLY
BACK DOOR STAY ASSEMBLY LH
BACK DOOR STAY ASSEMBLY RH
7.5 (235, 16 in.*lbf)
BACK DOOR
STOPPER RH
7.5 (235, 16 in.*lbf)
BACK DOOR STOPPER LH
ED
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B126540E01
ED–43
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT BACK DOOR
(a) Check that the clearance measurements of areas A
to D are within the standard range.
A
C
D
B
B075166E02
Standard measurement
Area
Specified Condition
Area
Specified Condition
A
6.6 +-1.5 mm (0.260 +-0.059 in.)
C
4.6 +-1.5 mm (0.181 +-0.059 in.)
B
5.8 +-1.5 mm (0.228 +-0.059 in.)
D
4.8 +-1.5 mm (0.189 +-0.059 in.)
ED
ED–44
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE NO. 2 REAR FLOOR BOARD
2.
REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX
3.
REMOVE NO. 3 REAR FLOOR BOARD
4.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
5.
REMOVE BACK DOOR LOWER TRIM BOARD
ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a screwdriver, detach the 11 clips and remove
the lower trim board.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
6.
REMOVE BACK DOOR UPPER TRIM BOARD
ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a screwdriver, detach the 5 clips and remove
the upper trim board.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
7.
REMOVE BACK DOOR TRIM UPPER PANEL
ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a screwdriver, detach the 5 clips and remove
the trim panel.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
8.
REMOVE BACK DOOR SIDE GARNISH LH
(a) Using a screwdriver, detach the 3 clips and remove
the garnish.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
w/o Rear Wiper
w/ Rear Wiper
ED
B077067E03
B075176E03
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR
9.
ED–45
REMOVE BACK DOOR SIDE GARNISH RH
(a) Using a screwdriver, detach the 3 clips and remove
the garnish.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
10. REMOVE REAR SPOILER SUB-ASSEMBLY (See
page ET-17)
11. REMOVE REAR WIPER MOTOR ASSEMBLY (See
page WW-22)
12. REMOVE BACK DOOR OUTSIDE GARNISH SUBASSEMBLY (See page ET-37)
13. REMOVE TELEVISION CAMERA ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 screws.
(b) Disconnect the connector and remove the camera.
14. REMOVE LICENSE PLATE LIGHT ASSEMBLY (See
page LI-92)
B131362
15. REMOVE BACK DOOR LOCK STRIKER ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a screwdriver, detach the 2 claws and remove
the cover.
B077068E01
(b) Using a T40 "torx" wrench, remove the 2 screws
and remove the cover.
16. REMOVE BACK DOOR STAY ASSEMBLY LH (See
page ED-49)
17. REMOVE BACK DOOR STAY ASSEMBLY RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the LH side.
18. REMOVE REAR DECK TRIM COVER (See page IR-10)
B075168E01
ED
ED–46
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR
19. REMOVE BACK DOOR LOCK ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the 3 bolts and door lock.
B075174E01
20. REMOVE BACK DOOR LOWER STOPPER
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and stopper LH and RH.
B075169E01
ED
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR
ED–47
ADJUSTMENT
HINT:
A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the standard
bolt chart (see page SS-2).
1.
ADJUST BACK DOOR
(a) Loosen the door side's hinge bolts and adjust the
back door panel's top end.
(b) Tighten the door side's hinge bolts after the
adjustment.
Torque: 15 N*m (153 kgf*cm, 11 ft.*lbf)
B075167E01
(c) Loosen the back door's lock bolts and change the
position of the back door lock to adjust back door
panel's end.
NOTICE:
Tap the base of the back door lock to change its
position.
(d) Tighten the 3 back door lock bolts after the
adjustment.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (76 kgf*cm, 75 in.*lbf)
B075752E01
ED
ED–48
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR
REASSEMBLY
HINT:
A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the standard
bolt chart (see page SS-2).
1.
INSTALL BACK DOOR LOCK ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the door lock with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (76 kgf*cm, 75 in.*lbf)
(b) Adjust the door lock (see page ED-45).
2.
INSTALL BACK DOOR LOWER STOPPER
(a) Install the stopper LH and RH with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
3.
INSTALL REAR DECK TRIM COVER (See page IR-16)
4.
INSTALL BACK DOOR STAY ASSEMBLY LH (See
page ED-49)
5.
INSTALL BACK DOOR STAY ASSEMBLY RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the LH side.
6.
INSTALL BACK DOOR LOCK STRIKER ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a T40 "torx" wrench, install the striker with the
2 screws.
Torque: 23 N*m (235 kgf*cm, 16 ft.*lbf)
B075174E01
B075169E01
B075168E01
(b) Attach the 2 claws to install the cover.
ED
7.
B077068E01
INSTALL LICENSE PLATE LIGHT ASSEMBLY (See
page LI-92)
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR
ED–49
8.
INSTALL TELEVISION CAMERA ASSEMBLY
(a) Connect the connector.
(b) Install the camera with the 2 screws.
9.
INSTALL BACK DOOR OUTSIDE GARNISH SUBASSEMBLY (See page ET-38)
10. INSTALL REAR WIPER MOTOR ASSEMBLY (See
page WW-22)
B131362
11. INSTALL REAR SPOILER SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page
ET-17)
12. INSTALL BACK DOOR SIDE GARNISH RH
(a) Attach the 3 clips to install the garnish.
13. INSTALL BACK DOOR SIDE GARNISH LH
(a) Attach the 3 clips to install the garnish.
14. INSTALL BACK DOOR TRIM UPPER PANEL
ASSEMBLY
(a) Attach the 11 clips to install the trim panel.
B075176E03
15. INSTALL BACK DOOR UPPER TRIM BOARD
ASSEMBLY
(a) Attach the 5 clips to install the upper trim board.
w/o Rear Wiper
w/ Rear Wiper
ED
B077067E03
ED–50
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR
16. INSTALL BACK DOOR LOWER TRIM BOARD
ASSEMBLY
(a) Attach the 11 clips to install the lower trim board.
17. CONNECT CABLE TO BATTERY NEGATIVE
TERMINAL
18. INSTALL NO. 3 REAR FLOOR BOARD
19. INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX
B075175E04
20. INSTALL NO. 2 REAR FLOOR BOARD
21. INSPECT SRS WARNING LIGHT
(a) Inspect the SRS warning light (see page RS-31).
22. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
ED
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR SUPPORT
ED–49
BACK DOOR SUPPORT
REMOVAL
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
Stop Ring
REMOVE BACK DOOR STAY ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the 2 stop rings and
stay.
(b) Remove the bolt labeled A from the door panel.
HINT:
Remove the door stay while supporting the back
door with your hands.
(c) Remove the 2 bolts labeled B and stay bracket from
the body panel.
Bolt A
Bracket
Bolt B
B079435E03
ED
ED–50
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR SUPPORT
INSTALLATION
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
Bolt A
Bracket
Bolt B
B079436E01
ED
INSTALL BACK DOOR STAY ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the stay bracket with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 7.0 N*m (71 kgf*cm, 62 in.*lbf) for bolt
labeled B
(b) Install the back door stay bolt to the back door.
Torque: 22.0 N*m (224 kgf*cm, 16 ft.*lbf) for bolt
labeled A
(c) Install the stay with the 2 stop rings.
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR – BACK DOOR SUPPORT
ED–51
DISPOSAL
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
CAUTION:
As metal debris may be blown outward by the gas, you
must:
• Wear protective glasses.
• Cover the area being cut.
NOTICE:
The gas is colorless, odorless and harmless.
1.
a
A
b
B
B065104E02
DISPOSE OF BACK DOOR STAY ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Horizontally fix the stay in a vise with the piston-rod
pulled out.
(b) Using a metal saw, gradually cut any area between
A and B (shown in the illustration) to release the
gas.
Specification:
Area
Measurement
a
80 mm (3.15 in.)
b
20 mm (0.80 in.)
ED
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
EI–1
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
(w/ Smart Key System)
PRECAUTION
NOTICE:
For initialization:
When disconnecting the cable from the negative (-)
battery terminal, initialize the following system after the
cable is reconnected.
System Name
Power Window Control System
See procedure
IN-32
For hybrid system activation:
• When the warning light is illuminated or the battery
has been disconnected and reconnected, pressing the
power switch may not start the system on the first try.
If so, press the power switch again.
• If the power switch is ON (IG), the battery is
disconnected, and the key is not in the key slot or not
within the key detection area during reconnection,
DTC B2799 (see page EI-25) may be output.
EI
EI–2
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
PARTS LOCATION
COMBINATION METER
EI
SECURITY INDICATOR
LIGHT
NETWORK GATEWAY ECU
CERTIFICATION ECU
POWER SOURCE
CONTROL ECU
HYBRID VEHICLE
CONTROL ECU
TRANSPONDER KEY ECU
KEY SLOT
TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU
ROOM OSCILLATOR
DOOR CONTROL RECEIVER
B126441E02
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
EI–3
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
Key (Door Control Transmitter)
Door Control Receiver
Certification ECU
EI
Room Oscillator
BEAN
Main Body ECU
Security
Indicator Light
Network Gateway ECU
Transmission Control
ECU
CAN
Power Source Control
ECU
Hybrid Vehicle Control
ECU
Transponder
Key Amplifier
Key Slot
Coil
BEAN
LIN
Transponder Key ECU
Unlock Warning
Switch
Halfway Switch
Full Switch
B126008E03
EI–4
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
EI
2.
Components
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
(a) The immobiliser system is a theft deterrent system
that determines whether or not to disable starting of
the hybrid control system depending on a
comparison of the key's ID code and the vehicle's
pre-registered code.
The immobiliser system compares the vehicle
transponder key ECU's pre-registered ID code with
the key-embedded transponder chip's ID code. If
the ID codes do not match, the immobiliser system
activates and the hybrid control system cannot be
started. The transponder key ECU manages
communication with the hybrid vehicle control ECU
and power source control ECU. When the ID codes
of the transponder chip and transponder key ECU
match, the transponder key ECU authorizes the
starting of the hybrid control system.
FUNCTION OF MAIN COMPONENTS
Outline
Transponder key coil/amplifier
Receives key ID code, amplifies ID code and outputs it to transponder
key ECU. Key ID code is received when key is inserted into key slot.
Halfway switch (inside key slot)
Detects if key is/is not inserted into key slot and outputs results to
transponder key ECU
Full switch (inside key slot)
Detects if key is/is not inserted into key slot and outputs results to
power source control ECU
Room oscillator
Transmits key detection signals within detection area in vehicle interior
upon receiving transmission request signal from certification ECU.
Entry key ECU request signal is activated when key is brought into
vehicle interior and, without inserting key into key slot, power switch is
pushed.
Door control receiver
Transmits ID code to certification ECU. Key ID code is received when
key is brought into vehicle interior and, without inserting key into key
slot, power switch is pushed
Security indicator light
Illuminates or starts flashing. Illumination is controlled by body ECU
3.
SYSTEM FUNCTION
(a) Starting hybrid control system with key inserted into
the key slot:
When the transponder key ECU detects that the
halfway switch is ON, the ECU provides current to
the transponder key coil and produces a faint
electric wave. A transponder chip in the key
receives the faint electric wave. Upon receiving the
faint electric wave, the transponder chip outputs a
key ID code signal. The transponder key coil
receives this signal, the transponder key amplifier
amplifies it, and then the signal is transmitted to the
transponder key ECU. The transponder key ECU
matches the key's ID code with the vehicle's ID
code, which was previously registered in the ECU. If
the ID codes match, the transponder key ECU turns
off the security indicator. Then when the power
switch is pushed, the code match results are sent
through the transponder key ECU to the power
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
EI–5
source control ECU, which authorizes the transition
of the power switch's power modes. The ACC, IG1
and IG2 relays are turned ON, supplying power to
the power switch ON (ACC) and ON (IG) power
modes. Also, the power source control ECU
changes the power switch's indicator to amber,
informing the driver that the power mode is set to
ON (IG). Then, the power source control ECU sends
a system start signal to the hybrid vehicle control
ECU. The hybrid vehicle control ECU confirms that
the key ID code has been verified. If the ID code has
been verified, the hybrid vehicle control ECU
bypasses the immobiliser system and starts the
hybrid control system.
(b) Starting hybrid control system without inserting the
key into key slot:
If a user operates the power switch while the key is
in the user's possession, the certification ECU
outputs a request signal to the room oscillator. The
room oscillator emits signals in order to form a key
detection area in the vehicle interior. The key then
sends its ID code signal to the certification ECU via
the door control receiver. The certification ECU
matches the key's ID code with the vehicle's ID
code, which was previously registered in the
transponder key ECU. If the ID codes match, the
transponder key ECU turns off the security indicator.
Then when the power switch is pushed, the code
match results are sent through the transponder key
ECU to the power source control ECU, which
authorizes the transition of the power switch's power
modes. The ACC, IG1 and IG2 relays are turned
ON, supplying power to the power switch ON (ACC)
and ON (IG) power modes. Also, the power source
control ECU changes the power switch's indicator to
amber, informing the driver that the power mode is
set to ON (IG). Then, the power source control ECU
sends a system start signal to the hybrid vehicle
control ECU. The hybrid vehicle control ECU
confirms that the key ID code has been verified. If
the ID code has been verified, the hybrid vehicle
control ECU bypasses the immobiliser system and
starts the hybrid control system.
EI
EI–6
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
• Use these procedures to troubleshoot the engine
immobiliser system.
• *: Use the intelligent tester.
1
EI
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
INSPECT BATTERY VOLTAGE
Standard voltage:
11 to 14 V
If the voltage is below 11 V, recharge or replace the battery
before proceeding
NEXT
3
START HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Result
Result
Proceed to
Power switch cannot be turned ON (ACC) or when hybrid control
system can be started
A
Power switch can be turned ON (ACC) and hybrid control system
cannot be started
B
B
Go to HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
A
4
CHECK FOR DTC*
(a) Check for DTCs and note any codes that are output (see
page EI-24).
(b) Delete the DTC.
(c) Recheck for DTCs. Try to prompt the DTC by simulating
the original activity that the DTC suggests.
Result:
Result
DTC reoccurs
A
DTC does not reoccur
B
B
A
Proceed to
Go to step 7
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
5
EI–7
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Result:
Result
Proceed to
Fault is not listed in problem symptoms
table
A
Fault is listed in problem symptoms
table
B
B
Go to step 7
A
6
OVERALL ANALYSIS AND TROUBLESHOOTING*
(a) DATA LIST/ACTIVE TEST (see page EI-24)
(b) Terminals of ECU (see page EI-18)
NEXT
7
ADJUST, REPAIR OR REPLACE
NEXT
8
NEXT
END
CONFIRMATION TEST
EI
EI–8
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
REGISTRATION
1.
DESCRIPTION OF CODE REGISTRATION
HINT:
• The key code (immobiliser code) is needed when the
transponder key ECU, hybrid vehicle control ECU,
certification ECU or key is replaced with a new one.
• The key has 3 codes: the key code, the entry code
and the wireless code. All of these code types need to
be registered when the key is replaced a with new
one. Refer to the following key code registration
procedures and the entry and wireless code
registration procedures (see page DL-142).
2.
PART REPLACEMENT AND KEY REGISTRATION
PROCEDURES
(a) The following table shows ECU replacement and
key registration procedures in case the
malfunctioning ECU has been determined after
troubleshooting the engine immobiliser system.
HINT:
• The following procedures indicated in the table
below require the use of the intelligent tester:
- New key code registration
- Additional key code registration
- Key code erasure
- ECU code registration
• If all of the registered keys are not available,
replacement of the transponder key ECU is also
required.
EI
Part to be replaced
Procedure
Refer to
1. Replace transponder key ECU
2. Reregister all keys
Transponder key ECU
3. Using SST (09843-018040), connect
terminals TC and CG of DLC3
4. Turn power switch ON (IG) and leave it as
is for 30 minutes
Certification ECU
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
"KEY REGISTRATION IN AUTOMATIC
REGISTRATION (NEW REGISTRATION)"
"ECU CODE REGISTRATION
(TRANSPONDER KEY ECU - HYBRID
VEHICLE CONTROL ECU)"
5. Register ECU communication ID to be
used between certification ECU and
transponder key ECU
"ECU CODE REGISTRATION
(TRANSPONDER KEY ECU CERTIFICATION ECU)"
1. Replace certification ECU
-
2. Register ECU communication ID to be
used between certification ECU and
transponder key ECU
"ECU CODE REGISTRATION
(TRANSPONDER KEY ECU CERTIFICATION ECU)"
1. Replace ECM
Refer to replacement (see page ES-469)
2. Using SST (09843-018040), connect
terminals TC and CG of DLC3
3. Turn power switch ON (IG) and leave it as
is for 30 minutes
Key
-
"ECU CODE REREGISTRATION
(TRANSPONDER KEY ECU - HYBRID
VEHICLE CONTROL ECU)"
1. Using remaining key, erase key code of lost
key
"ERASURE OF KEY CODE"
2. Register additional keys as necessary
"REGISTRATION OF ADDITIONAL KEY
(ADDITIONAL REGISTRATION)"
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
3.
EI–9
KEY REGISTRATION IN AUTOMATIC REGISTRATION
(NEW REGISTRATION)
(a) When a key is inserted into the key slot, the key
code (immobiliser code) registration is automatic. In
this mode, a maximum of 2 key codes can be
registered.
HINT:
• When a new transponder key ECU is installed,
key codes (immobiliser codes) must be
registered in the transponder key ECU.
• New transponder key ECU are automatically set
to automatic key code registration mode.
EI
EI–10
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
Security Indicator Light
Blinking
(Until first key is inserted)
START
EI
Insert key into key slot
ON
Registration begins
(Registration is completed approx. 1 second after key is inserted)
OFF
(Approx. 1 second)
Remove key
ON
(When maximum number of
key codes are registered,
security indicator light
remains off until last key
registered is removed. After it
is removed, security indicator
light starts blinking)
Yes
Register another key?
No
END
B113366E05
(b) End automatic key code registration mode.
Automatic key code registration mode can be forced
to end when at least 1 key code (immobiliser code)
for the key has been registered.
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
EI–11
(1) Turn the power switch from ON (IG) and OFF 5
times within 10 seconds using the already
registered key.
HINT:
• When no key is inserted into the key slot in
automatic key code registration mode, the
security indicator light remains on.
• When the immobiliser system is operating
normally and the key is pulled out, the
security indicator light blinks continuously.
• If the key code registration has failed in
automatic key code registration mode, code
2-1 will be output from the security indicator
light. Trying to reregister an already
registered key will cause code 2-2 to be
output when the key is inserted. If the
number of registered key codes exceeds the
limit, code 2-3 will be output from the
security indicator light. The output details
are shown below.
EI
EI–12
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
0.2 sec.
Normal
(Immobiliser system
is operating normally)
ON
OFF
1.8 sec.
EI
0.25 sec.
0.5 sec.
1.0 sec.
ON
Code 2-1
OFF
0.25 sec.
0.25 sec.
0.5 sec.
1.0 sec.
ON
Code 2-2
OFF
0.25 sec.
0.25 sec.
0.5 sec.
1.0 sec.
ON
Code 2-3
OFF
0.25 sec.
B113367E01
4.
REGISTRATION OF ADDITIONAL KEY (ADDITIONAL
REGISTRATION)
(a) Register an additional key using the intelligent
tester.
HINT:
• A maximum of 5 key codes can be registered.
• Registration mode will be ended if each step is
not completed within the specified time.
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
EI–13
Security Indicator Light
START
Blinking
(Until first key is
inserted)
Insert already registered key into key slot and turn power switch
ON (IG)
EI
Intelligent tester operation:
1. Select PRIUS from menu
2. Select W/ SMART KEY
OFF
Within 120
seconds
3. Select IMMOBILISER
4. Select ID UTILITY
5. Select TRANSP CODE REG.
After above operation, proceed to next step according to
prompts on tester screen
Within 20 seconds
after tester instruction
After turning power switch OFF, remove key
ON
Insert key to be registered in key slot
Blinking
Within 10 seconds
After 60 seconds, key is registered.
(Security indicator light turns off)
OFF
END
B113368E08
HINT:
• A brief outline of procedures for key code
registration is shown above. For more detailed
information, refer to the intelligent tester screen's
instructions.
EI–14
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
• When the immobiliser system is operating
normally and key is pulled out, the security
indicator light blinks continuously.
• If the key code registration has failed in
automatic key code registration mode, code 2-1
will be output from the security indicator light.
Trying to reregister an already registered key will
be cause code 2-2 to be output when the key is
inserted. If the number of registered key codes
exceeds the limit, code 2-3 will be output from
the security indicator light. The output details are
shown in the "KEY REGISTRATION IN
AUTOMATIC REGISTRATION (NEW
REGISTRATION)" procedures.
EI
5.
ERASURE OF KEY CODE
(a) Erase the key codes using the intelligent tester.
HINT:
• All key codes are erased except for the key that
is used to erase the key codes. In order to use a
key whose code has been erased, a new key
code must be registered.
• Registration will be canceled if each step is not
completed within the specified time.
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
EI–15
Security Indicator Light
START
Blinking
(Until first key is
inserted)
EI
Insert already registered key into key slot and turn power switch
ON (IG)
Intelligent tester operation:
1. Select PRIUS from menu
2. Select W/ SMART KEY
OFF
Within 120
seconds
3. Select IMMOBILISER
4. Select ID UTILITY
5. Select IMMOB CODE ERS
After above operation, proceed to next step according to
prompts on tester screen
ON for 1 second
then OFF
Within 10 seconds
after tester instruction
After turning power switch OFF, remove key
Blinking
END
B113369E05
HINT:
• A brief outline of procedures for the key code
erasure is shown above. For more detailed
information, refer to the intelligent tester screen's
instructions.
EI–16
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
• When the immobiliser system is operating
normally and key is pulled out, the security
indicator light blinks continuously.
6.
EI
ECU COMMUNICATION ID REGISTRATION
(TRANSPONDER KEY ECU - HYBRID VEHICLE
CONTROL ECU)
NOTICE:
• If the transponder key ECU and/or hybrid vehicle
control ECU has been replaced, register the ECU
communication ID to both ECUs in order to match
their IDs.
• The hybrid control system cannot be started
unless the ECU communication ID matches.
• When the transponder key ECU has been
replaced, do not turn the power switch from ON to
OFF 20 times or more consecutively. The ECU
communication ID must be registered before such
an occurrence or the transponder key ECU will
need to be replaced. If the transponder key ECU is
unable to be recognize the hybrid vehicle control
ECU, the hybrid control system will be unable to
be started. If the transponder key ECU cannot
recognize the hybrid vehicle control ECU, the
transponder key ECU must be replaced again with
a new one.
• After the registration, pressing the power switch
may not start the system on the first try. If so,
press the poser switch again.
• After the hybrid control system is started, erase
DTC B2799 (code for hybrid vehicle control ECU's
immobiliser communication error) using either of
the following:
- Using the intelligent tester (see page EI-24).
- Disconnect the battery for 30 seconds.
(a) Register the ECU communication ID.
(b) Using SST, connect terminals TC and CG of the
DLC3.
SST 09843-18040
CG
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10111213141516
DLC3
TC
SST
B135493E01
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG) (do not start the
hybrid control system) and leave it as is for 30
minutes.
(d) Turn the power switch OFF and disconnect
terminals TC and CG.
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
EI–17
(e) Check that the hybrid control system starts.
7.
ECU COMMUNICATION ID REGISTRATION
(TRANSPONDER KEY ECU - CERTIFICATION ECU)
Security Indicator Light
EI
START
Blinking
(Until first key is
inserted)
Insert already registered key into key slot and turn power switch
ON (IG)
Intelligent tester operation:
1. Select PRIUS from menu
2. Select W/ SMART KEY
OFF
Within 120
seconds
2. Select IMMOBILISER
3. Select ID UTILITY
4. Select ECU COMM ID REG
After above operation, proceed to next step according to
prompts on tester screen
ON for 1 second
then OFF
Within 10 seconds
after tester instruction
After turning power switch OFF, remove key
Blinking
END
B113369E06
EI–18
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
HINT:
• A brief outline of procedures for key code registration
is shown above. For more detailed information, refer
to the intelligent tester screen's instructions.
• When the engine immobiliser system is operating
normally and the key is pulled out, the security
indicator light blinks continuously.
8.
EI
ECU COMMUNICATION ID REREGISTRATION
(TRANSPONDER KEY ECU - HYBRID VEHICLE
CONTROL ECU)
NOTICE:
• The ECU communication ID should be registered
when the hybrid vehicle control ECU is replaced
in order to match the ECU communication ID
(transponder key ECU - hybrid vehicle control
ECU).
• The hybrid control system cannot be started
unless the ECU communication ID (transponder
key ECU - hybrid vehicle control ECU) matches.
(a) Insert the already registered key in the key slot and
turn the power switch ON (READY) with the brake
pedal depressed.
(b) Check that the hybrid control system stays on for
more than 3 seconds.
EI–19
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
• Use the table below to help determine the cause of the
problem symptom. The potential causes of the symptoms
are listed in order of probability in the "Suspected area"
column of the table. Check each symptom by checking the
suspected areas in the order they are listed. Replace parts
as necessary.
• Inspect the fuses and relays related to this system before
inspecting the suspected areas below.
Engine immobiliser system
Symptom
Hybrid control system does not start
Suspected area
See page
1. Power source circuit
EI-47
2. Hybrid control system
HV-21
EI
EI–20
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
CHECK KEY SLOT
K3
7 6 5 4 3 2 1
EI
B126055E01
(a) Disconnect the K3 key slot connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
GND (K3-7) - Body ground
Wiring Color
P - Body ground
Terminal Description
Ground
Condition
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
Always
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
(c) Reconnect the K3 key slot connector.
(d) Measure the resistance and voltage of the
connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
GND (K3-7) - Body ground
P - Body ground
Ground
VC5 (K3-1) - GND (K3-7)
Y-P
Power source
CODE (K3-4) - GND (K37)
L-P
Demodulated signal of key
code data
TXCT (K3-5) - GND (K3-7) LG - P
Condition
Key code output signal
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
Always
No key in key slot
Below 1 V
Key inserted
4.6 to 5.4 V
No key in key slot
Below 1 V
Key inserted
Pulse generation (see
waveform 1)
No key in key slot
Below 1 V
Key inserted
Pulse generation (see
waveform 2)
If the result is not as specified, the key slot
(amplifier) may have a malfunction.
(e) Using an oscilloscope, check the waveform 1.
Waveform 1 (Reference):
Waveform 1
Item
Symbols (Terminal No.)
GND
B135496E01
Content
CODE (K3-4) - GND (K3-7)
Tool Setting
2 V/DIV., 20 msec./DIV.
Condition
Key inserted
EI–21
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
(f)
Using an oscilloscope, check the waveform 2.
Waveform 2 (Reference):
Waveform 2
Item
Content
Symbols (Terminal No.)
GND
TXCT (K3-5) - GND (K3-7)
Tool Setting
2 V/DIV., 10 msec./DIV.
Condition
Key inserted
2.
CHECK TRANSPONDER KEY ECU
EI
B135497E01
T5
9 8 7 6
5 4 3 2 1
24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10
B126056E01
(a) Disconnect the T5 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance and voltage of the wire
harness side connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
GND (T5-22) - Body
ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
AGND (T5-7) - GND (T522)
P - W-B
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
CPUB (T5-3) - GND (T522)
L - W-B
+B (CPUB) power supply
Always
10 to 14 V
IG (T5-4) - GND (T5-22)
O - W-B
Ignition power supply
Power switch OFF
Blow 1 V
CUWS (T5-5) - GND (T522)
B - W-B
Halfway switch signal
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
No key in key slot
Below 1 Ω
Key inserted
10 kΩ or higher
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
(c) Reconnect the T5 ECU connector.
(d) Measure the voltage of the connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
CUWS (T5-5) - GND (T522)
VC5 (T5-20) - GND (T522)
Wiring Color
B - W-B
Y - W-B
Terminal Description
Halfway switch signal
Key slot power source
Condition
No key in key slot
Specified Condition
10 to 14 V
Key inserted
Below 1 V
No key in key slot
Below 1 V
Key inserted
4.6 to 5.4 V
EI–22
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
Symbols (Terminal No.)
CODE (T5-21) - GND (T522)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
L - W-B
Transponder key amplifier
communication signal
EI
TXCT (T5-6) - GND (T522)
LG - P
HEV0 (T5-19) - GND (T522)
W - W-B
Hybrid vehicle control
ECU output signal
HEV1 (T5-18) - GND (T522)
R - W-B
Hybrid vehicle control
ECU input signal
Condition
Specified Condition
No key in key slot
Below 1 V
Key inserted
Pulse generation (see
waveform 1)
No key in key slot
Below 1 V
Key inserted
Pulse generation (see
waveform 2)
Power switch OFF
Below 1 V
Power switch ON (IG)
Pulse generation (see
waveform 3)
Always
Pulse generation (see
waveform 4)
If the result is not as specified, the ECU may have a
malfunction.
(e) Using an oscilloscope, check the waveform 1.
Waveform 1 (Reference):
Waveform 1
Item
Content
Symbols (Terminal No.)
CODE (T5-21) - GND (T5-22)
Tool Setting
2 V/DIV., 20 msec./DIV.
Condition
Key inserted
GND
B135496E01
(f)
Waveform 2
Using an oscilloscope, check the waveform 2.
Waveform 2 (Reference):
Item
GND
B135497E01
Content
Symbols (Terminal No.)
TXCT (T5-6) - GND (T5-22)
Tool Setting
2 V/DIV., 10 msec./DIV.
Condition
Key inserted
EI–23
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
(g) Using an oscilloscope, check the waveform 3.
Waveform 3 (Reference):
Waveform 3
Item
Content
Symbols (Terminal No.)
GND
HEV0 (T5-19) - GND (T5-22)
Tool Setting
10 V/DIV., 100 msec./DIV.
Condition
Power switch ON (IG)
EI
B135498E01
(h) Using an oscilloscope, check the waveform 4.
Waveform 4 (Reference):
Waveform 4
Item
GND
Content
Symbols (Terminal No.)
HEV1 (T5-18) - GND (T5-22)
Tool Setting
10 V/DIV., 100 msec./DIV.
Condition
Always
3.
CHECK CERTIFICATION ECU
B135499E01
S11
17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10
9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18
B126057E01
(a) Disconnect the S11 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance and voltage of the wire
harness side connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
E (S11-17) - Body ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
+B1 (S11-1) - E (S11-17)
R - W-B
Battery power supply
Always
10 to 14 V
KSW (S11-4) - E (S11-17)
Y - W-B
Halfway switch signal
IG (S11-18) - E (S11-17)
B - W-B
Ignition switch supply
No key in key slot
10 kΩ or higher
Key inserted
Below 1 Ω
Power switch OFF
Below 1 V
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
EI–24
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
CHECK HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
4.
H17
EI
7
6
5
4
H16
3
2
1
7
6
5
4
H14
H15
3
2
1
6
5
4
3
2
1
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
17 16 15 14 13 12 11 19 9 8
19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7
27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18
27 26
25 24
23 22 21 20
27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17
25 24
23 22 21 20 19 18
34 33
35 34
33 32
31 30 29 28
35 34 33 32 31
31 30
29 28
32 31 30 29 28
30 29 28
17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8
27 26
B126058E01
(a) Measure the resistance and voltage of the
connectors.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
GND1 (H14-1) - Body
ground
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always
ST2 (H14-5) - GND1
(H14-1)
Y - W-B
Ignition ready control
signal input
Hybrid control system
stopped and power switch
ON (READY)
IGSW (H14-7) - GND1
(H14-1)
O - W-B
Ignition start control signal
input
Hybrid control system
stopped and power switch
ON (IG)
BATT (H15-6) - GND1
(H14-1)
Y - W-B
Battery
Always
L - W-B
Ignition power supply
Power switch ON (IG)
IMI (H14-18) - GND2
(H14-4)
W - W-B
Transponder key ECU
input signal
Always
Pulse generation (see
waveform 1)
IMO (H14-26) - GND2
(H14-4)
Transponder key ECU
output signal
Power switch OFF
Below 1 V
R - W-B
Power switch ON (IG)
Pulse generation (see
waveform 2)
GND 2 (H14-4) - Body
ground
+B1 (H16-7) - GND1
(H14-1)
+B2 (H16-6) - GND1
(H14-1)
10 to 14 V
If the result is not as specified, the ECM may have a
malfunction.
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
EI–25
(b) Using an oscilloscope, check the waveform 1.
Waveform 1 (Reference):
Waveform 1
Item
Symbols (Terminal No.)
GND
Content
IMI (H14-18) - GND2 (H14-4)
Tool Setting
10 V/DIV., 100 msec./DIV.
Condition
Always
EI
B135499E02
(c) Using an oscilloscope, check the waveform 2.
Waveform 2 (Reference):
Waveform 2
Item
GND
B135498E02
Content
Symbols (Terminal No.)
IMO (H14-26) - GND2 (H14-4)
Tool Setting
10 V/DIV., 100 msec./DIV.
Condition
Power switch ON (IG)
EI–26
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
EI
1.
DESCRIPTION
(a) The hybrid vehicle control ECU controls vehicle's
immobiliser system function. Immobiliser system
data and the Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) can
be read through the vehicle's Data Link Connector 3
(DLC3). In some cases, a malfunction may be
occurring in the immobiliser system even though the
security indicator light is off. When the system
seems to be malfunctioning, use the intelligent
tester to check for malfunctions and perform repairs.
2.
CHECK DLC3
(a) The vehicle uses the ISO 15765-4 communication
protocol. The terminal arrangement of the DLC3
complies with SAE J1962 and matches the ISO
15765-4 format.
CG SG CANH SIL
CANL
BAT
H100769E16
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Terminal Description
SIL (7) - SG (5)
Bus "+" line
CG (4) - Body ground
Chassis ground
SG (5) - Body ground
Signal ground
BAT (16) - Body ground
Battery positive
Condition
During transmission
Always
Pulse generation
Below 1 Ω
11 to 14 V
54 to 69 Ω
CANH (6) - CANL (14)
CANH (6) - Battery positive
HIGH-level CAN bus line
CANH (6) - CG (4)
1 kΩ or higher
Power switch OFF
CANL (14) - Battery positive
CANL (14) - CG (4)
Specified Condition
LOW-level CAN bus line
1 kΩ or higher
1 MΩ or higher
1 MΩ or higher
If the result is not as specified, the DLC3 may have
a malfunction. Repair or replace the harness and
connector.
HINT:
Connect the cable of the intelligent tester (with CAN
VIM) to the DLC3, turn the power switch ON (IG)
and attempt to use the tester. If the screen displays
the message UNABLE TO CONNECT TO
VEHICLE, there is a problem either with the vehicle
or with the tester.
• If communication is normal when the tester is
connected to another vehicle, inspect the DLC3
of the original vehicle.
• If communication is still not possible when the
tester is connected to another vehicle, the
problem is probably in the tester itself. Consult
the Service Department listed in the tester's
instruction manual.
Intelligent Tester
DLC3
CAN VIM
B126098E01
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
EI–27
DTC CHECK / CLEAR
Intelligent Tester
1.
2.
DLC3
CAN VIM
B126098E01
CHECK DTC
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Read the DTCs by following the directions on the
tester's screen.
CLEAR DTC
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Erase the DTCs by following the directions on the
tester's screen.
EI
EI–28
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST
1.
EI
READ DATA LIST
HINT:
Using the intelligent tester's DATA LIST allows switch,
sensor, actuator and other item values to be read without
removing any parts. Reading the DATA LIST early in
troubleshooting is one way to save time.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Read the DATA LIST by following the directions on
the tester screen.
Transponder key ECU:
Item
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
KEY UNLK WRN SW
Unlock warning switch signal /
ON or OFF
ON: Key is in key slot
OFF: No key is in key slot
-
SHIFT POS
Shift position P signal / ON or
OFF
ON: Shift position is P
OFF: Shift position is not P
-
+B
Battery voltage / NORMAL or
BREAK
NORMAL: Battery supply is
normal
BREAK: Battery supply is
malfunctioning
-
ANTENNA COIL
Transponder key coil condition /
NORMAL or FAIL
NORMAL: Transponder key coil
is normal
FAIL: Transponder key coil is
malfunctioning
-
IMMOBILISER
Immobiliser system status / SET
or UNSET
SET: Without key
UNSET: Power switch ON (IG)
-
CHECK (SECURITY)
Verification with entry key ECU /
NORMAL or ABNORMAL
NORMAL: Verified with entry key
ECU
ABNORMAL: Not verified with
entry key ECU
-
REMIT (START)
Hybrid control system starting
control / OK or NG
OK: Hybrid control system
starting is permitted
NG: Hybrid control system is not
permitted
-
G-CODE SUPPORT
G-code support / SUPPORT or
NOT SUP
SUPPORT: G-code is supported
NOT SUP: G-code is not
supported
-
MASTER KEY
Key code signal / NOMATCH or
MATCH
MATCH: Key code is send
NOMATCH: Unmatched key code
is sent
-
REGIST MAS CODE
Number of registered key / min.:
0; max.: 5
Number of registered key
-
2.
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST
HINT:
Performing the intelligent tester's ACTIVE TEST allows
relay, VSV, actuator and other items to be operated
without removing any parts. Performing the ACTIVE
TEST early in troubleshooting is one way to save time.
The DATA LIST can be displayed during the ACTIVE
TEST.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
EI–29
(c) Perform the ACTIVE TEST by following the
directions on the tester's screen.
Transponder key ECU:
Item
NOT P-POS WARN
Test Details
Shift p-pos warning is ON / OFF
Diagnostic Note
-
METER CHIME
Meter chime is ON / OFF
-
METER BUZ
Meter buzzer is ON / OFF
-
SECURITY INDC
Turn security indicator light ON / OFF
-
EI
EI–30
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
1.
TRANSPONDER KEY ECU DTC CHART
Transponder key ECU:
DTC No.
EI
Detection Item
Trouble Area
See page
B2775
Interior Verification Abnormal (To
Theft Deterrent ECU)
- Transponder key ECU
- Certification ECU
- Smart key system
EI-27
B2784
Antenna Coil Open / Short
- Wire harness
- Key slot
- Transponder key ECU
EI-30
B2785
Communication Malfunction
between ECUs Connected by LIN
- Wire harness
- Transponder key ECU
- Power source control ECU
EI-33
B2793
Transponder Chip Malfunction
Key (door control transmitter)
EI-35
B2794
Unmatched Encryption Code
Key (door control transmitter)
EI-36
B2795
Unmatched Key Code
Key (door control transmitter)
EI-37
B2796
No Communication in Immobiliser
System
- Key (door control transmitter)
- Key slot
- Wire harness
EI-38
B2797
Communication Malfunction No. 1
- Key (door control transmitter)
- Wire harness
- Key slot
EI-41
B2798
Communication Malfunction No. 2
- Key (door control transmitter)
EI-38
2.
HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU DTC CHART
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
See page
B2799-539
Engine Immobiliser System
Malfunction
- Wire harness
- Transponder key ECU
- Hybrid vehicle control ECU
EI-44
B2799-540
Engine Immobiliser System
Malfunction
- Wire harness
- Transponder key ECU
- Hybrid vehicle control ECU
EI-44
B2799-541
Engine Immobiliser System
Malfunction
- Wire harness
- Transponder key ECU
- Hybrid vehicle control ECU
EI-44
B2799-542
Engine Immobiliser System
Malfunction
- Wire harness
- Transponder key ECU
- Hybrid vehicle control ECU
EI-44
B2799-543
Engine Immobiliser System
Malfunction
- Wire harness
- Transponder key ECU
- Hybrid vehicle control ECU
EI-44
B2799-544
Engine Immobiliser System
Malfunction
- Wire harness
- Transponder key ECU
- Hybrid vehicle control ECU
EI-44
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
DTC
B2775
EI–31
Interior Verification Abnormal (To Theft Deterrent ECU)
DESCRIPTION
This DTC is output when: 1) there is no response from the certification ECU, 2) the ECU communication
ID was unable to be registered properly, 3) a communication error occurs between the transponder key
ECU and certification ECU.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
When any of following conditions are met:
• There is no response from certification
ECU
• ECU communication ID is unable to be
registered properly
• Communication error occurs between
transponder key ECU and certification
ECU
B2775
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Transponder key ECU
Certification ECU
Smart key system (for door lock)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Delete the DTC (see page EI-24).
(b) Check for DTCs when turning the power switch ON (IG)
without inserting the key into the key slot.
Result:
Result
Proceed to
DTC reoccurs
A
DTC does not reoccur
B
B
NORMAL
A
2
CHECK CERTIFICATION ECU (VERIFICATION)
(a) Check that the smart indicator on the meter is ON.
Result:
Result
Proceed to
Smart indicator is ON
A
Smart indicator is OFF
B
B
GO TO SMART KEY SYSTEM (for Door lock)
A
3
CHECK TRANSPONDER KEY ECU
(a) Insert the key into the key slot.
(b) Check that the power switch can be turned ON (IG).
OK:
Power switch can be turned ON (IG).
EI
EI–32
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
OK
Go to step 5
NG
4
CHECK FOR DTC (IMMOBILISER SYSTEM DTC)
(a) Check for DTCs and note any codes that are output (see
page EI-24).
(b) Delete the DTC.
(c) Recheck for DTCs. Try to prompt the DTC by simulating
the original activity that the DTC suggests.
Result:
EI
Result
Proceed to
DTC does not reoccur
A
DTC reoccurs
B
NG
GO TO DTC CHART
OK
5
REREGISTER ECU COMMUNICATION ID CODE
(a) Reregister the ECU communication ID code with a
transponder key ECU and certification ECU (see page
EI-7).
(b) Check that the power switch can be turned ON (IG) even
if the key is not inserted into the key slot.
OK:
Power switch can be turned ON (IG) without key in
key slot
OK
NORMAL
NG
6
CHECK TRANSPONDER KEY ECU (OPERATION)
(a) Temporarily replace the transponder key ECU with a new
or normally functioning one.
(b) Check that the power switch can be turned ON (ACC or
IG) and the hybrid control system can be started.
Result:
Result
Proceed to
Power switch can be turned ON (ACC and IG) and hybrid control
system can be started with/without inserting key into key slot
A
Power switch cannot be turned ON (ACC and IG) and hybrid control
system cannot be started without inserting key into key slot
B
Power switch cannot be turned (ACC and IG) and hybrid control
system cannot be started with inserting key into key slot
C
B
REPLACE CERTIFICATION ECU
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
C
EI–33
GO TO SMART KEY SYSTEM
A
END (TRANSPONDER KEY ECU IS DEFECTIVE)
EI
EI–34
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
DTC
B2784
Antenna Coil Open / Short
DESCRIPTION
This DTC is detected when a transponder key coil (antenna coil) is open/shorted.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
B2784
EI
Antenna coil is open/shorted
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Wire harness
Key slot
Transponder key ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
Transponder Key ECU
Key Slot
Transponder Key Amplifier
ANT2
VC5
CODE
VC5
CODE
Transponder
Key Coil
TXCT
GND
ANT1
TXCT
AGND
B121682E08
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
EI–35
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (TRANSPONDER KEY COIL)
(a) Check the DATA LIST for proper functioning of the
transponder key coil.
Transponder key ECU:
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Item
Transponder key coil condition /
NORMAL or FAIL
ANTENNA COIL
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
NORMAL: Transponder key coil
is normal
FAIL: Transponder key coil is
malfunctioning
-
OK:
NORMAL (transponder key coil is normal) appears
on screen.
OK
REPLACE TRANSPONDER KEY ECU
NG
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TRANSPONDER KEY ECU - KEY SLOT)
(a) Disconnect the T5 ECU connector.
(b) Disconnect the K3 key slot connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Transponder Key ECU
TXCT
AGND
Tester Connection
T5-20 (VC5) - K3-1 (VC5)
T5-21 (CODE) - K3-4 (CODE)
T5
1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8 9
T5-6 (TXCT) - K3-5 (TXCT)
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
T5-7 (AGND) - K3-7 (GND)
VC5
CODE
T5-20 (VC5) or K3-1 (VC5) - Body
ground
T5-21 (CODE) or K3-4 (CODE) - Body
ground
T5-6 (TXCT) or K3-5 (TXCT) - Body
ground
Key Slot
T5-7 (AGND) or K3-7 (GND) - Body
ground
NG
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
K3
VC5
GND
CODE
10 kΩ or higher
TXCT
B126099E01
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
EI
EI–36
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
OK
REPLACE KEY SLOT
EI
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
DTC
B2785
EI–37
Communication Malfunction between ECUs
Connected by LIN
DESCRIPTION
This DTC is output if communication between the transponder key ECU and power source control ECU is
not possible.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Communication between transponder key
ECU and power source control ECU is not
possible
B2785
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Wire harness
Power source control ECU
Transponder key ECU
EI
WIRING DIAGRAM
Power Source Control ECU
LIN1
Transponder Key ECU
LIN1
B126100E01
EI–38
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TRANSPONDER KEY ECU - POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU)
(a) Reconnect the T5 and P6 ECU connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Transponder Key ECU
Tester Connection
EI
T5
1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8 9
Specified Condition
T5-14 (LIN1) - P6-30 (LIN1)
Below 1 Ω
T5-14 (LIN1) or P6-30 (LIN1) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
NG
LIN1
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
Power Source Control ECU
P6
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40
LIN1
B126101E01
OK
2
CHECK TRANSPONDER KEY ECU (OPERATION)
(a) Temporarily replace the transponder key ECU with a new
or normally functioning one.
(b) Check that the power switch can be turned ON (ACC
and IG) and the hybrid control system can be started.
OK:
Power switch can be turned ON (ACC and IG) and
hybrid control system can be started.
NG
OK
END (TRANSPONDER KEY ECU IS DEFECTIVE)
REPLACE POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
DTC
B2793
EI–39
Transponder Chip Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
This DTC is output when: 1) during key code registration, a key malfunction occurs; or 2) the key code
was unable to be registered properly. Follow the inspection procedure below.
DTC No.
B2793
DTC Detection Condition
Transponder chip malfunction
Trouble Area
Key (door control transmitter)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
EI
1
REREGISTER KEY
(a) Delete the DTC (see page EI-24).
(b) Reregister the key (which caused this DTC to be output)
with the transponder key ECU (see page EI-7).
(c) Insert the same key into the key slot.
(d) Check that the power switch can be turned ON (ACC
and IG) and the hybrid control system can be started.
OK:
Power switch can be turned (ACC and IG) and
hybrid control system can be started.
NG
OK
END
REPLACE KEY
EI–40
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
DTC
B2794
Unmatched Encryption Code
DESCRIPTION
This DTC is output when a key with an incomplete key code is inserted into the key slot.
DTC No.
B2794
DTC Detection Condition
Key with incomplete key code is inserted
Trouble Area
Key (door control transmitter)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
EI
1
REREGISTER KEY
(a) Delete the DTC (see page EI-24).
(b) Reregister the key (which caused this DTC to be output)
with the transponder key ECU (see page EI-7).
(c) Insert the same key into the key slot.
(d) Check that the power switch can be turned ON (ACC
and IG) and the hybrid control system can be started.
OK:
Power switch can be turned (ACC and IC) and
hybrid control system can be started.
NG
OK
END
REPLACE KEY
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
DTC
B2795
EI–41
Unmatched Key Code
DESCRIPTION
This DTC is output when a key with a key code that has not been registered in the ECU is inserted into the
key slot.
DTC No.
B2795
DTC Detection Condition
Key with unregistered code is inserted
Trouble Area
Key (door control transmitter)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
EI
1
REREGISTER KEY
(a) Delete the DTC (see page EI-24).
(b) Reregister the key (which caused this DTC to be output)
with the transponder key ECU (see page EI-7).
(c) Insert the same key into the key slot.
(d) Check that the power switch can be turned ON (ACC
and IG) and the hybrid control system can be started.
OK:
Power switch can be turned (ACC and IC) and
hybrid control system can be started.
NG
OK
END
REPLACE KEY
EI–42
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
DTC
B2796
No Communication in Immobiliser System
DTC
B2798
Communication Malfunction No. 2
DESCRIPTION
When a key is inserted into the key slot but no communication occurs between the key and transponder
key ECU, DTC B2796 is output. When a key is inserted into the key slot but a communication error occurs
between the key and transponder key ECU, DTC B2798 is output.
DTC No.
EI
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B2796
No communication
•
•
•
•
Key (door control transmitter)
Wire harness
Key slot
Transponder key ECU
B2798
Communication error
Key (door control transmitter)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Transponder Key ECU
Key Slot
Transponder Key Amplifier
ANT2
VC5
CODE
VC5
CODE
Transponder
Key Coil
TXCT
GND
ANT1
TXCT
AGND
B121682E09
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
EI–43
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM)
(a) Check the DATA LIST for proper functioning of the
engine immobiliser system.
Transponder key ECU:
Item
IMMOBILISER
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Engine immobiliser system status
/ SET or UNSET
Normal Condition
SET: No key is in key slot
UNSET: Power switch ON (IG)
Diagnostic Note
-
OK:
"UNSET" (power switch ON (IG)) appears on
screen.
OK
REPLACE TRANSPONDER KEY ECU
NG
2
CHECK DOOR CONTROL TRANSMITTER (OPERATION)
(a) Temporarily replace the door control transmitter with a
new or normally functioning one.
(b) Check that change the power switch can be turned ON
(IG).
OK:
Power switch can be turned ON (ACC and IG) and
hybrid control system can be started.
OK
END (DOOR CONTROL TRANSMITTER IS
DEFECTIVE)
NG
3
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (TRANSPONDER KEY COIL)
(a) Check the DATA LIST for proper functioning of the
transponder key coil.
Transponder key ECU:
Item
ANTENNA COIL
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Transponder key coil condition /
NORMAL or FAIL
Normal Condition
NORMAL: Transponder key coil
is normal
FAIL: Transponder key coil is
malfunctioning
Diagnostic Note
-
OK:
"NORMAL" (transponder key coil is normal) is
appears on screen.
NG
OK
REPLACE KEY SLOT
EI
EI–44
4
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TRANSPONDER KEY ECU - KEY SLOT)
(a) Disconnect the T5 ECU connector.
(b) Disconnect the K3 key slot connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Transponder Key ECU
TXCT
Tester Connection
T5-20 (VC5) - K3-1 (VC5)
AGND
EI
T5-21 (CODE) - K3-4 (CODE)
T5
1 2 3 4 5
Specified Condition
6 7 8 9
T5-6 (TXCT) - K3-5 (TXCT)
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
Below 1 Ω
T5-7 (AGND) - K3-7 (GND)
VC5
T5-20 (VC5) or K3-1 (VC5) - Body
ground
CODE
T5-21 (CODE) or K3-4 (CODE) - Body
ground
T5-6 (TXCT) or K3-5 (TXCT) - Body
ground
Key Slot
T5-7 (AGND) or K3-7 (GND) - Body
ground
NG
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
K3
VC5
10 kΩ or higher
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
GND
CODE
TXCT
B126099E01
OK
5
CHECK KEY SLOT (OPERATION)
(a) Temporarily replace the key slot with a new or normally
functioning one.
(b) Check that the power switch can be turned ON (ACC
and IG) and the hybrid control system can be started.
OK:
Power switch can be turned ON (ACC and IG) and
hybrid control system can be started.
NG
OK
END (KEY SLOT IS DEFECTIVE)
REPLACE TRANSPONDER KEY ECU
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
DTC
B2797
EI–45
Communication Malfunction No. 1
DESCRIPTION
This DTC is output when a communication error occurs between the key slot and transponder key ECU. A
possible reason for the communication error is that noise is occurring on the communication line.
Following the inspection procedure below.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Key has noise occurring on communication
line
B2797
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
Key (door control transmitter)
Wire harness
Key slot
Transponder key ECU
EI
WIRING DIAGRAM
Key Slot
CODE
Transponder Key ECU
CODE
B121683E05
EI–46
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK TRANSPONDER KEY ECU
(a) Using an oscilloscope or the intelligent tester, check for
noise in the waveform between the terminals of the K3
key slot connector and T5 ECU connector.
OK:
No noise is present (see illustration).
Transponder Key ECU
EI
9 8 7 6
5 4 3 2 1
24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10
T5
CODE
7 6 5 4 3 2 1
CODE
Noise should
not appear.
B126102E01
OK
Tool Setting
T21-15 (CODE) T20-4 (CODE)
NG
Key Slot
K3
Tester
Connection
5 V/DIV., 20
msec./DIV.
Condition
Key inserted
Specified
Condition
No noise is
present
FIND CAUSE OF NOISE AND REMOVE IT
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
2
EI–47
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TRANSPONDER KEY ECU - KEY SLOT)
(a) Disconnect the T5 ECU connector.
(b) Disconnect the K3 key slot connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Transponder Key ECU
Tester Connection
T21-5 (CODE) - K3-4 (CODE)
T5
1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8 9
NG
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
CODE
Key Slot
K3
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
CODE
B126099E02
OK
3
CHECK KEY SLOT (OPERATION)
(a) Temporarily replace the key slot with a new or normally
functioning one.
(b) Check that the power switch can be turned ON (ACC
and IG) and the hybrid control system can be started.
OK:
Power switch can be turned ON (ACC and IG) and
hybrid control system can be turned.
NG
OK
END (KEY SLOT IS DEFECTIVE)
REPLACE TRANSPONDER KEY ECU
EI
EI–48
EI
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
DTC
B2799-539 Engine Immobiliser System Malfunction
DTC
B2799-540 Engine Immobiliser System Malfunction
DTC
B2799-541 Engine Immobiliser System Malfunction
DTC
B2799-542 Engine Immobiliser System Malfunction
DTC
B2799-543 Engine Immobiliser System Malfunction
DTC
B2799-544 Engine Immobiliser System Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
These DTCs are detected when: 1) the wire harness between the transponder key ECU and hybrid
vehicle control ECU is open or shorted, 2) the ECU communication IDs of the hybrid vehicle control ECU
and transponder key ECU are different, 3) the start ON (READY) signal is delayed, or 4) the key codes
are unmatched.
Before troubleshooting for these DTCs, make sure no transponder key ECU DTCs are present. If present,
troubleshoot the transponder key ECU DTCs or hybrid vehicle control ECU DTCs first.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
When any of the following conditions are met:
• Wire harness between transponder key
ECU and hybrid vehicle control ECU is
open or short
• ECU communication IDs of hybrid vehicle
control ECU and transponder key ECU
are different
• ON (READY) signal is delayed more than
10 seconds from when power switch is
turned to ON (READY)
• Key codes are unmatched
B2799-539
B2799-540
B2799-541
B2799-542
B2799-543
B2799-544
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Wire harness
Transponder key ECU
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
Hybrid Vehicle Control ECU
Transponder Key ECU
IMI
HEV0
IMO
HEV1
B121684E11
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
EI–49
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Delete the DTC (see page EI-24).
(b) Check that no DTC is output.
OK:
DTC is not output.
OK
END
EI
NG
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TRANSPONDER KEY ECU - HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU)
(a) Disconnect the T5 and H14 ECU connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Tester Connection
Transponder Key ECU
T5-19 (HEV0) - H14-18 (IMI)
T5-18 (HEV1) - H14-26 (IMO)
1 2 3 4 5
T5
T5-19 (HEV0) or H14-18 (IMI) - Body
ground
6 7 8 9
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
T5-18 (HEV1) or H14-26 (IMO) - Body
ground
HEV1
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
10 kΩ or higher
HEV0
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
Hybrid Vehicle Control ECU
H14
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
IMI
18 19 20 21 22 23
24 25
26 27
30 31
28 29
IMO
B126103E01
OK
3
CHECK TRANSPONDER KEY ECU (OPERATION)
(a) Temporarily replace the transponder key ECU with a new
or normally functioning one.
(b) Check that the power switch can be turned ON (ACC
and IG) and the hybrid control system can be started.
EI–50
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
OK:
Power switch can be turned ON (ACC and IG) and
hybrid control system can be started.
NG
OK
END (TRANSPONDER KEY ECU IS DEFECTIVE)
EI
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
EI–51
Power Source Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This circuit provides power to operate the transponder key ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Transponder Key ECU
P CON MAIN
CPUB
P/I
AM2
IG2
IGN
IG
to Power Source Control ECU
MAIN
GND
B126104E02
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK POWER SWITCH (OPERATION)
(a) Check that the power switch can be turned.
HINT:
• Without depressing the brake pedal, push the power
switch repeatedly. Power switch should change as
following: OFF→ ON (ACC) → ON (IG) → OFF.
EI
EI–52
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/ Smart Key System)
• With depressing the brake pedal, push the power
switch repeatedly. Power switch should change as
following: OFF→ ON (ACC) → ON (IG) → ON
(READY) → OFF.
NG
GO TO SMART KEY SYSTEM (for Starting)
OK
2
INSPECT FUSE (IGN, P CON MAIN, AM2)
EI
(a) Remove the IGN fuse from the instrument panel junction
block.
(b) Remove the P CON MAIN and AM2 fuses from the
engine room junction block.
(c) Measure the resistance of the fuses.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE FUSE
OK
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TRANSPONDER KEY ECU - BATTERY AND BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the T5 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance and voltage of the wire harness
side connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Tester Connection
CPUB
IG
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
T5-22 (GND) - Body ground
Standard voltage
T5
1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8 9
Tester Connection
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
T5-4 (IG) - Body ground
GND
T5-3 (CPUB) - Body
ground
B126105E01
NG
Condition
Specified Condition
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
Power switch OFF
Below 1 V
Always
10 to 14 V
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
EI–49
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM
(w/o Smart Key System)
PRECAUTION
NOTICE:
For initialization:
When disconnecting the cable from the negative (-)
battery terminal, initialize the following system after the
cable is reconnected.
System Name
Power Window Control System
See procedure
IN-32
For hybrid system activation:
• When the warning light is illuminated or the battery
has been disconnected and reconnected, pressing the
power switch may not start the system on the first try.
If so, press the power switch again.
• If the power switch is ON (IG), the battery is
disconnected, and the key is not in the key slot or not
within the key detection area during reconnection,
DTC B2799 (see page EI-70) may be output.
EI
EI–50
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
PARTS LOCATION
COMBINATION METER
EI
SECURITY INDICATOR
LIGHT
NETWORK GATEWAY ECU
POWER SOURCE
CONTROL ECU
HYBRID VEHICLE
CONTROL ECU
TRANSPONDER KEY ECU
KEY SLOT
TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU
B126637E01
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
EI–51
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
Key (Door Control Transmitter)
EI
Main Body ECU
Security
Indicator Light
Network Gateway ECU
Transmission Control
ECU
CAN
Power Source Control
ECU
Hybrid Vehicle Control
ECU
Key Slot
Coil
Transponder
Key Amplifier
BEAN
LIN
Transponder Key ECU
Unlock Warning
Switch
Halfway Switch
Full Switch
B126638E03
EI–52
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
EI
2.
Components
ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
(a) The immobiliser system is a theft deterrent system
that determines whether or not to disable starting of
the hybrid control system depending on a
comparison of the key's ID code and the vehicle's
pre-registered code.
The immobiliser system compares the vehicle
transponder key ECU's pre-registered ID code with
the key-embedded transponder chip's ID code. If
the ID codes do not match, the immobiliser system
activates and the hybrid control system cannot be
started. The transponder key ECU manages
communication with the hybrid vehicle control ECU
and power source control ECU. When the ID codes
of the transponder chip and transponder key ECU
match, the transponder key ECU authorizes the
starting of the hybrid control system.
FUNCTION OF MAIN COMPONENTS
Outline
Transponder key coil/amplifier
Receives key ID code, amplifies ID code and outputs it to transponder
key ECU. Key ID code is received when key is inserted into key slot.
Halfway switch (inside key slot)
Detects if key is/is not inserted into key slot and outputs results to
transponder key ECU
Full switch (inside key slot)
Detects if key is/is not inserted into key slot and outputs results to
power source control ECU
Security indicator light
Illuminates or starts flashing. Illumination is controlled by body ECU
3.
SYSTEM FUNCTION
(a) When the transponder key ECU detects that the
halfway switch is ON, the ECU provides current to
the transponder key coil and produces a faint
electric wave. A transponder chip in the key
receives the faint electric wave. Upon receiving the
faint electric wave, the transponder chip outputs a
key ID code signal. The transponder key coil
receives this signal, the transponder key amplifier
amplifies it, and then the signal is transmitted to the
transponder key ECU. The transponder key ECU
matches the key's ID code with the vehicle's ID
code, which was previously registered in the ECU. If
the ID codes match, the transponder key ECU turns
off the security indicator. Then when the power
switch is pushed, the code match results are sent
through the transponder key ECU to the power
source control ECU, which authorizes the transition
of the power switch's power modes. The ACC, IG1
and IG2 relays are turned ON, supplying power to
the power switch ON (ACC) and ON (IG) power
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
EI–53
modes. Also, the power source control ECU
changes the power switch's indicator to amber,
informing the driver that the power mode is set to
ON (IG). Then, the power source control ECU sends
a system start signal to the hybrid vehicle control
ECU. The hybrid vehicle control ECU confirms that
the key ID code has been verified. If the ID code has
been verified, the hybrid vehicle control ECU
bypasses the immobiliser system and starts the
hybrid control system.
EI
EI–54
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
• Use these procedures to troubleshoot the engine
immobiliser system.
• *: Use the intelligent tester.
1
EI
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
INSPECT BATTERY VOLTAGE
Standard voltage:
11 to 14 V
If the voltage is below 11 V, recharge or replace the battery
before proceeding
NEXT
3
START HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Result:
Result
Proceed to
Power switch cannot be turned ON (ACC) or when hybrid control
system can be started
A
Power switch can be turned ON (ACC) and hybrid control system
cannot be started
B
B
Go to HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
A
4
CHECK FOR DTC*
(a) Check for DTCs and note any codes that are output (see
page EI-69).
(b) Delete the DTC.
(c) Recheck for DTCs. Try to prompt the DTC by simulating
the original activity that the DTC suggests.
Result:
Result
DTC reoccurs
A
DTC does not reoccur
B
B
A
Proceed to
Go to step 7
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
5
EI–55
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Result:
Result
Proceed to
Fault is not listed in problem symptoms
table
A
Fault is listed in problem symptoms
table
B
B
Go to step 7
A
6
OVERALL ANALYSIS AND TROUBLESHOOTING*
(a) DATA LIST/ACTIVE TEST (see page EI-69)
(b) Terminals of ECU (see page EI-63)
NEXT
7
ADJUST, REPAIR OR REPLACE
NEXT
8
NEXT
END
CONFIRMATION TEST
EI
EI–56
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
REGISTRATION
1.
DESCRIPTION OF CODE REGISTRATION
HINT:
• The key code (immobiliser code) is needed when the
transponder key ECU, hybrid vehicle control ECU or
key is replaced with a new one.
• The key has 2 codes: the key code and the wireless
code. Both of these code types need to be registered
when the key is replaced with a new one. Refer to the
following key code registration procedures and the
entry and wireless code registration procedures (see
page DL-95).
2.
PART REPLACEMENT AND KEY REGISTRATION
PROCEDURES
(a) The following table shows ECU replacement and
key registration procedures in case the
malfunctioning ECU has been determined after
troubleshooting the engine immobiliser system.
HINT:
• The following procedures indicated in the table
below require the use of the intelligent tester:
- New key code registration
- Additional key code registration
- Key code erasure
- ECU code registration
• If all of the registered keys are not available,
replacement of the transponder key ECU is also
required.
EI
Part to be replaced
Procedure
1. Replace transponder key ECU
2. Reregister all keys
Transponder key ECU
3. Using SST (09843-018040), connect
terminals TC and CG of DLC3
4. Turn power switch ON (IG) and leave it as
is for 30 minutes
1. Replace ECM
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
2. Using SST (09843-018040), connect
terminals TC and CG of DLC3
3. Turn power switch ON (IG) and leave it as
is for 30 minutes
Key
Refer to
"KEY REGISTRATION IN AUTOMATIC
REGISTRATION (NEW REGISTRATION)"
"ECU CODE REGISTRATION
(TRANSPONDER KEY ECU - HYBRID
VEHICLE CONTROL ECU)"
Refer to replacement (see page ES-469)
"ECU CODE REREGISTRATION
(TRANSPONDER KEY ECU - HYBRID
VEHICLE CONTROL ECU)"
1. Using remaining key, erase key code of lost
key
"ERASURE OF KEY CODE"
2. Register additional keys as necessary
"REGISTRATION OF ADDITIONAL KEY
(ADDITIONAL REGISTRATION)"
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
3.
EI–57
KEY REGISTRATION IN AUTOMATIC REGISTRATION
(NEW REGISTRATION)
(a) When a key is inserted into the key slot, the key
code (immobiliser code) registration is automatic. In
this mode, a maximum of 2 key codes can be
registered.
HINT:
• When a new transponder key ECU is installed,
key codes (immobiliser codes) must be
registered in the transponder key ECU.
• New transponder key ECU are automatically set
to automatic key code registration mode.
EI
EI–58
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
Security Indicator Light
Blinking
(Until first key is inserted)
START
EI
Insert key into key slot
ON
Registration begins
(Registration is completed approx. 1 second after key is inserted)
OFF
(Approx. 1 second)
Remove key
ON
(When maximum number of
key codes are registered,
security indicator light
remains off until last key
registered is removed. After it
is removed, security indicator
light starts blinking)
Yes
Register another key?
No
END
B113366E05
(b) End automatic key code registration mode.
Automatic key code registration mode can be forced
to end when at least 1 key code (immobiliser code)
for the key has been registered.
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
EI–59
(1) Turn the power switch from ON (IG) and OFF 5
times within 10 seconds using the already
registered key.
HINT:
• When no key is inserted into the key slot in
automatic key code registration mode, the
security indicator light remains on.
• When the immobiliser system is operating
normally and the key is pulled out, the
security indicator light blinks continuously.
• If the key code registration has failed in
automatic key code registration mode, code
2-1 will be output from the security indicator
light. Trying to reregister an already
registered key will cause code 2-2 to be
output when the key is inserted. If the
number of registered key codes exceeds the
limit, code 2-3 will be output from the
security indicator light. The output details
are shown below.
EI
EI–60
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
0.2 sec.
Normal
(Immobiliser system
is operating normally)
ON
OFF
1.8 sec.
EI
0.25 sec.
0.5 sec.
1.0 sec.
ON
Code 2-1
OFF
0.25 sec.
0.25 sec.
0.5 sec.
1.0 sec.
ON
Code 2-2
OFF
0.25 sec.
0.25 sec.
0.5 sec.
1.0 sec.
ON
Code 2-3
OFF
0.25 sec.
B113367E01
4.
REGISTRATION OF ADDITIONAL KEY (ADDITIONAL
REGISTRATION)
(a) Register an additional key using the intelligent
tester.
HINT:
• A maximum of 5 key codes can be registered.
• Registration mode will be ended if each step is
not completed within the specified time.
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
EI–61
Security Indicator Light
START
Blinking
(Until first key is
inserted)
Insert already registered key into key slot and turn power switch
ON (IG)
EI
Intelligent tester operation:
1. Select PRIUS from menu
2. Select W/O SMART KEY
OFF
Within 120
seconds
3. Select IMMOBILISER
4. Select ID UTILITY
5. Select TRANSP CODE REG.
After above operation, proceed to next step according to
prompts on tester screen
Within 20 seconds
after tester instruction
After turning power switch OFF, remove key
ON
Insert key to be registered in key slot
Blinking
Within 10 seconds
After 60 seconds, key is registered.
(Security indicator light turns off)
OFF
END
B113368E09
HINT:
• A brief outline of procedures for key code
registration is shown above. For more detailed
information, refer to the intelligent tester screen's
instructions.
EI–62
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
• When the immobiliser system is operating
normally and key is pulled out, the security
indicator light blinks continuously.
• If the key code registration has failed in
automatic key code registration mode, code 2-1
will be output from the security indicator light.
Trying to reregister an already registered key will
be cause code 2-2 to be output when the key is
inserted. If the number of registered key codes
exceeds the limit, code 2-3 will be output from
the security indicator light. The output details are
shown in the "KEY REGISTRATION IN
AUTOMATIC REGISTRATION (NEW
REGISTRATION)" procedures.
EI
5.
ERASURE OF KEY CODE
(a) Erase the key codes using the intelligent tester.
HINT:
• All key codes are erased except for the key that
is used to erase the key codes. In order to use a
key whose code has been erased, a new key
code must be registered.
• Registration will be canceled if each step is not
completed within the specified time.
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
EI–63
Security Indicator Light
START
Blinking
(Until first key is
inserted)
EI
Insert already registered key into key slot and turn power switch
ON (IG)
Intelligent tester operation:
1. Select PRIUS from menu
2. Select W/O SMART KEY
OFF
Within 120
seconds
3. Select IMMOBILISER
4. Select ID UTILITY
5. Select IMMOB CODE ERS
After above operation, proceed to next step according to
prompts on tester screen
ON for 1 second
then OFF
Within 10 seconds
after tester instruction
After turning power switch OFF, remove key
Blinking
END
B113369E07
HINT:
• A brief outline of procedures for the key code
erasure is shown above. For more detailed
information, refer to the intelligent tester screen's
instructions.
EI–64
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
• When the immobiliser system is operating
normally and key is pulled out, the security
indicator light blinks continuously.
6.
EI
ECU COMMUNICATION ID REGISTRATION
(TRANSPONDER KEY ECU - HYBRID VEHICLE
CONTROL ECU)
NOTICE:
• If the transponder key ECU and/or hybrid vehicle
control ECU has been replaced, register the ECU
communication ID to both ECUs in order to match
their IDs.
• The hybrid control system cannot be started
unless the ECU communication ID matches.
• When the transponder key ECU has been
replaced, do not turn the power switch from ON to
OFF 20 times or more consecutively. The ECU
communication ID must be registered before such
an occurrence or the transponder key ECU will
need to be replaced. If the transponder key ECU is
unable to be recognize the hybrid vehicle control
ECU, the hybrid control system will be unable to
be started. If the transponder key ECU cannot
recognize the hybrid vehicle control ECU, the
transponder key ECU must be replaced again with
a new one.
• After the registration, pressing the power switch
may not start the system on the first try. If so,
press the poser switch again.
• After the hybrid control system is started, erase
DTC B2799 (code for hybrid vehicle control ECU's
immobiliser communication error) using either of
the following:
- Using the intelligent tester (see page EI-69).
- Disconnect the battery for 30 seconds.
(a) Register the ECU communication ID.
(b) Using SST, connect terminals TC and CG of the
DLC3.
SST 09843-18040
CG
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10111213141516
DLC3
TC
SST
B135493E01
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG) (do not start the
hybrid control system) and leave it as is for 30
minutes.
(d) Turn the power switch OFF and disconnect
terminals TC and CG.
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
EI–65
(e) Check that the hybrid control system starts.
7.
ECU COMMUNICATION ID REREGISTRATION
(TRANSPONDER KEY ECU - HYBRID VEHICLE
CONTROL ECU)
NOTICE:
• The ECU communication ID should be registered
when the hybrid vehicle control ECU is replaced
in order to match the ECU communication ID
(transponder key ECU - hybrid vehicle control
ECU).
• The hybrid control system cannot be started
unless the ECU communication ID (transponder
key ECU - hybrid vehicle control ECU) matches.
(a) Insert the already registered key in the key slot and
turn the power switch ON (READY) with the brake
pedal depressed.
(b) Check that the hybrid control system stays on for
more than 3 seconds.
EI
EI–66
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
• Use the table below to help determine the cause of the
problem symptom. The potential causes of the symptoms
are listed in order of probability in the "Suspected area"
column of the table. Check each symptom by checking the
suspected areas in the order they are listed. Replace parts
as necessary.
• Inspect the fuses and relays related to this system before
inspecting the suspected areas below.
EI
Engine immobiliser system
Symptom
Hybrid control system does not start
Suspected area
See page
1. Power source circuit
EI-89
2. Hybrid control system
HV-21
EI–67
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
CHECK KEY SLOT
K3
7 6 5 4 3 2 1
EI
B126055E01
(a) Disconnect the K3 key slot connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
GND (K3-7) - Body ground
Wiring Color
P - Body ground
Terminal Description
Ground
Condition
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
Always
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
(c) Reconnect the K3 key slot connector.
(d) Measure the resistance and voltage of the
connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
GND (K3-7) - Body ground
P - Body ground
Ground
VC5 (K3-1) - GND (K3-7)
Y-P
Power source
CODE (K3-4) - GND (K37)
L-P
Demodulated signal of key
code data
TXCT (K3-5) - GND (K3-7)
LG - P
Key code output signal
Condition
Specified Condition
Always
Below 1 Ω
No key in key slot
Below 1 V
Key inserted
4.6 to 5.4 V
No key in key slot
Below 1 V
Key inserted
Pulse generation (see
waveform 1)
No key in key slot
Below 1 V
Key inserted
Pulse generation (see
waveform 2)
If the result is not as specified, the key slot
(amplifier) may have a malfunction.
(e) Using an oscilloscope, check the waveform 1.
Waveform 1 (Reference):
Waveform 1
Item
Symbols (Terminal No.)
GND
B135496E01
Content
CODE (K3-4) - GND (K3-7)
Tool Setting
2 V/DIV., 20 msec./DIV.
Condition
Key inserted
EI–68
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
(f)
Using an oscilloscope, check the waveform 2.
Waveform 2 (Reference):
Waveform 2
Item
Content
Symbols (Terminal No.)
GND
TXCT (K3-5) - GND (K3-7)
Tool Setting
2 V/DIV., 10 msec./DIV.
Condition
Key inserted
2.
CHECK TRANSPONDER KEY ECU
EI
B135497E01
T5
9 8 7 6
5 4 3 2 1
24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10
B126056E01
(a) Disconnect the T5 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance and voltage of the wire
harness side connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
GND (T5-22) - Body
ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
AGND (T5-7) - GND (T522)
P - W-B
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
CPUB (T5-3) - GND (T522)
L - W-B
+B (CPUB) power supply
Always
10 to 14 V
IG (T5-4) - GND (T5-22)
O - W-B
Ignition power supply
Power switch OFF
Blow 1 V
CUWS (T5-5) - GND (T522)
B - W-B
Halfway switch signal
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
No key in key slot
Below 1 Ω
Key inserted
10 kΩ or higher
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
(c) Reconnect the T5 ECU connector.
(d) Measure the voltage of the connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
CUWS (T5-5) - GND (T522)
VC5 (T5-20) - GND (T522)
Wiring Color
B - W-B
Y - W-B
Terminal Description
Halfway switch signal
Key slot power source
Condition
Specified Condition
No key in key slot
10 to 14 V
Key inserted
Below 1 V
No key in key slot
Below 1 V
Key inserted
4.6 to 5.4 V
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
Symbols (Terminal No.)
CODE (T5-21) - GND (T522)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
L - W-B
Transponder key amplifier
communication signal
TXCT (T5-6) - GND (T522)
LG - P
HEV0 (T5-19) - GND (T522)
W - W-B
Hybrid vehicle control
ECU output signal
HEV1 (T5-18) - GND (T522)
R - W-B
Hybrid vehicle control
ECU input signal
Condition
EI–69
Specified Condition
No key in key slot
Below 1 V
Key inserted
Pulse generation (see
waveform 1)
No key in key slot
Below 1 V
Key inserted
Pulse generation (see
waveform 2)
Power switch OFF
Below 1 V
Power switch ON (IG)
Pulse generation (see
waveform 3)
Always
Pulse generation (see
waveform 4)
If the result is not as specified, the ECU may have a
malfunction.
(e) Using an oscilloscope, check the waveform 1.
Waveform 1 (Reference):
Waveform 1
Item
Content
Symbols (Terminal No.)
CODE (T5-21) - GND (T5-22)
Tool Setting
2 V/DIV., 20 msec./DIV.
Condition
Key inserted
GND
B135496E01
(f)
Waveform 2
Using an oscilloscope, check the waveform 2.
Waveform 2 (Reference):
Item
GND
B135497E01
Content
Symbols (Terminal No.)
TXCT (T5-6) - GND (T5-22)
Tool Setting
2 V/DIV., 10 msec./DIV.
Condition
Key inserted
EI
EI–70
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
(g) Using an oscilloscope, check the waveform 3.
Waveform 3 (Reference):
Waveform 3
Item
Content
Symbols (Terminal No.)
GND
HEV0 (T5-19) - GND (T5-22)
Tool Setting
10 V/DIV., 100 msec./DIV.
Condition
Power switch ON (IG)
EI
B135498E01
(h) Using an oscilloscope, check the waveform 4.
Waveform 4 (Reference):
Waveform 4
Item
GND
Content
Symbols (Terminal No.)
HEV1 (T5-18) - GND (T5-22)
Tool Setting
10 V/DIV., 100 msec./DIV.
Condition
Always
3.
CHECK HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
B135499E01
H17
7
6
5
4
H16
3
2
1
7
6
5
4
3
H14
H15
2
1
6
5
4
3
2
1
7
6
5
4
3
2
1
17 16 15 14 13 12 11 19 9 8
19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8
16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7
27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18
27 26
25 24
23 22 21 20
27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17
25 24
23 22 21 20 19 18
34 33
35 34
33 32
31 30 29 28
35 34 33 32 31
31 30
29 28
32 31 30 29 28
30 29 28
17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8
27 26
B126058E01
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
EI–71
(a) Measure the resistance and voltage of the
connectors.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
GND1 (H14-1) - Body
ground
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Below 1 Ω
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always
ST2 (H14-5) - GND1
(H14-1)
Y - W-B
Ignition ready control
signal input
Hybrid control system
stopped and power switch
ON (READY)
IGSW (H14-7) - GND1
(H14-1)
O - W-B
Ignition start control signal
input
Hybrid control system
stopped and power switch
ON (IG)
GND 2 (H14-4) - Body
ground
BATT (H15-6) - GND1
(H14-1)
Specified Condition
10 to 14 V
Y - W-B
Battery
Always
L - W-B
Ignition power supply
Power switch ON (IG)
IMI (H14-18) - GND2
(H14-4)
W - W-B
Transponder key ECU
input signal
Always
Pulse generation (see
waveform 1)
IMO (H14-26) - GND2
(H14-4)
Transponder key ECU
output signal
Power switch OFF
Below 1 V
R - W-B
Power switch ON (IG)
Pulse generation (see
waveform 2)
+B1 (H16-7) - GND1
(H14-1)
+B2 (H16-6) - GND1
(H14-1)
If the result is not as specified, the ECM may have a
malfunction.
(b) Using an oscilloscope, check the waveform 1.
Waveform 1 (Reference):
Waveform 1
Item
GND
B135499E02
Content
Symbols (Terminal No.)
IMI (H14-18) - GND2 (H14-4)
Tool Setting
10 V/DIV., 100 msec./DIV.
Condition
Always
EI
EI–72
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
(c) Using an oscilloscope, check the waveform 2.
Waveform 2 (Reference):
Waveform 2
Item
Symbols (Terminal No.)
GND
EI
B135498E02
Content
IMO (H14-26) - GND2 (H14-4)
Tool Setting
10 V/DIV., 100 msec./DIV.
Condition
Power switch ON (IG)
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
EI–73
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
1.
DESCRIPTION
(a) The hybrid vehicle control ECU controls vehicle's
immobiliser system function. Immobiliser system
data and the Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) can
be read through the vehicle's Data Link Connector 3
(DLC3). In some cases, a malfunction may be
occurring in the immobiliser system even though the
security indicator light is off. When the system
seems to be malfunctioning, use the intelligent
tester to check for malfunctions and perform repairs.
2.
CHECK DLC3
(a) The vehicle uses the ISO 15765-4 communication
protocol. The terminal arrangement of the DLC3
complies with SAE J1962 and matches the ISO
15765-4 format.
CG SG CANH SIL
CANL
BAT
H100769E16
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Terminal Description
SIL (7) - SG (5)
Bus "+" line
CG (4) - Body ground
Chassis ground
SG (5) - Body ground
Signal ground
BAT (16) - Body ground
Battery positive
Condition
During transmission
Always
Below 1 Ω
11 to 14 V
54 to 69 Ω
CANH (6) - CANL (14)
CANH (6) - Battery positive
HIGH-level CAN bus line
CANH (6) - CG (4)
1 kΩ or higher
Power switch OFF
CANL (14) - Battery positive
CANL (14) - CG (4)
Specified Condition
Pulse generation
LOW-level CAN bus line
1 kΩ or higher
1 MΩ or higher
1 MΩ or higher
If the result is not as specified, the DLC3 may have
a malfunction. Repair or replace the harness and
connector.
HINT:
Connect the cable of the intelligent tester (with CAN
VIM) to the DLC3, turn the power switch ON (IG)
and attempt to use the tester. If the screen displays
the message UNABLE TO CONNECT TO
VEHICLE, there is a problem either with the vehicle
or with the tester.
• If communication is normal when the tester is
connected to another vehicle, inspect the DLC3
of the original vehicle.
• If communication is still not possible when the
tester is connected to another vehicle, the
problem is probably in the tester itself. Consult
the Service Department listed in the tester's
instruction manual.
Intelligent Tester
DLC3
CAN VIM
B126098E01
EI
EI–74
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
DTC CHECK / CLEAR
Intelligent Tester
1.
2.
EI
DLC3
CAN VIM
B126098E01
CHECK DTC
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Read the DTCs by following the directions on the
tester's screen.
CLEAR DTC
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Erase the DTCs by following the directions on the
tester's screen.
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
EI–75
DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST
1.
READ DATA LIST
HINT:
Using the intelligent tester's DATA LIST allows switch,
sensor, actuator and other item values to be read without
removing any parts. Reading the DATA LIST early in
troubleshooting is one way to save time.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Read the DATA LIST by following the directions on
the tester screen.
Transponder key ECU:
Item
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
KEY UNLK WRN SW
Unlock warning switch signal /
ON or OFF
ON: Key is in key slot
OFF: No key is in key slot
-
SHIFT POS
Shift position P signal / ON or
OFF
ON: Shift position is P
OFF: Shift position is not P
-
+B
Battery voltage / NORMAL or
BREAK
NORMAL: Battery supply is
normal
BREAK: Battery supply is
malfunctioning
-
ANTENNA COIL
Transponder key coil condition /
NORMAL or FAIL
NORMAL: Transponder key coil
is normal
FAIL: Transponder key coil is
malfunctioning
-
IMMOBILISER
Immobiliser system status / SET
or UNSET
SET: Without key
UNSET: Power switch ON (IG)
-
REMIT (START)
Hybrid control system starting
control / OK or NG
OK: Hybrid control system
starting is permitted
NG: Hybrid control system is not
permitted
-
G-CODE SUPPORT
G-code support / SUPPORT or
NOT SUP
SUPPORT: G-code is supported
NOT SUP: G-code is not
supported
-
MASTER KEY
Key code signal / NOMATCH or
MATCH
MATCH: Key code is send
NOMATCH: Unmatched key code
is sent
-
REGIST MAS CODE
Number of registered key / min.:
0; max.: 5
Number of registered key
-
2.
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST
HINT:
Performing the intelligent tester's ACTIVE TEST allows
relay, VSV, actuator and other items to be operated
without removing any parts. Performing the ACTIVE
TEST early in troubleshooting is one way to save time.
The DATA LIST can be displayed during the ACTIVE
TEST.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
EI
EI–76
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
(c) Perform the ACTIVE TEST by following the
directions on the tester's screen.
Transponder key ECU:
Item
EI
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
NOT P-POS WARN
Shift p-pos warning is ON / OFF
-
METER CHIME
Meter chime is ON / OFF
-
METER BUZ
Meter buzzer is ON / OFF
-
SECURITY INDC
Turn security indicator light ON / OFF
-
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
EI–77
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
1.
TRANSPONDER KEY ECU DTC CHART
Transponder key ECU
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
See page
B2784
Antenna Coil Open / Short
- Wire harness
- Key slot
- Transponder key ECU
EI-72
B2785
Communication Malfunction
between ECUs Connected by LIN
- Wire harness
- Transponder key ECU
- Power source control ECU
EI-75
B2793
Transponder Chip Malfunction
Key (door control transmitter)
EI-77
B2794
Unmatched Encryption Code
Key (door control transmitter)
EI-78
B2795
Unmatched Key Code
Key (door control transmitter)
EI-79
B2796
No Communication in Immobiliser
System
- Key (door control transmitter)
- Key slot
- Wire harness
EI-80
B2797
Communication Malfunction No. 1
- Key (door control transmitter)
- Wire harness
- Key slot
EI-83
B2798
Communication Malfunction No. 2
- Key (door control transmitter)
EI-80
2.
HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU DTC CHART
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
See page
B2799-539
Engine Immobiliser System
Malfunction
- Wire harness
- Transponder key ECU
- Hybrid vehicle control ECU
B2799-540
Engine Immobiliser System
Malfunction
- Wire harness
- Transponder key ECU
- Hybrid vehicle control ECU
EI-86
B2799-541
Engine Immobiliser System
Malfunction
- Wire harness
- Transponder key ECU
- Hybrid vehicle control ECU
EI-86
B2799-542
Engine Immobiliser System
Malfunction
- Wire harness
- Transponder key ECU
- Hybrid vehicle control ECU
EI-86
B2799-543
Engine Immobiliser System
Malfunction
- Wire harness
- Transponder key ECU
- Hybrid vehicle control ECU
EI-86
B2799-544
Engine Immobiliser System
Malfunction
- Wire harness
- Transponder key ECU
- Hybrid vehicle control ECU
EI-86
EI-86
EI
EI–78
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
DTC
B2784
Antenna Coil Open / Short
DESCRIPTION
This DTC is detected when a transponder key coil (antenna coil) is open/shorted.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
B2784
EI
Antenna coil is open/shorted
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Wire harness
Key slot
Transponder key ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
Transponder Key ECU
Key Slot
Transponder Key Amplifier
ANT2
VC5
CODE
VC5
CODE
Transponder
Key Coil
TXCT
GND
ANT1
TXCT
AGND
B121682E08
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
EI–79
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (TRANSPONDER KEY COIL)
(a) Check the DATA LIST for proper functioning of the
transponder key coil.
Transponder key ECU:
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Item
Transponder key coil condition /
NORMAL or FAIL
ANTENNA COIL
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
NORMAL: Transponder key coil
is normal
FAIL: Transponder key coil is
malfunctioning
-
OK:
NORMAL (transponder key coil is normal) appears
on screen.
OK
REPLACE TRANSPONDER KEY ECU
NG
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TRANSPONDER KEY ECU - KEY SLOT)
(a) Disconnect the T5 ECU connector.
(b) Disconnect the K3 key slot connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Transponder Key ECU
TXCT
AGND
Tester Connection
T5-20 (VC5) - K3-1 (VC5)
T5-21 (CODE) - K3-4 (CODE)
T5
1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8 9
T5-6 (TXCT) - K3-5 (TXCT)
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
T5-7 (AGND) - K3-7 (GND)
VC5
CODE
T5-20 (VC5) or K3-1 (VC5) - Body
ground
T5-21 (CODE) or K3-4 (CODE) - Body
ground
T5-6 (TXCT) or K3-5 (TXCT) - Body
ground
Key Slot
T5-7 (AGND) or K3-7 (GND) - Body
ground
NG
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
K3
VC5
GND
CODE
10 kΩ or higher
TXCT
B126099E01
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
EI
EI–80
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
OK
REPLACE KEY SLOT
EI
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
DTC
B2785
EI–81
Communication Malfunction between ECUs
Connected by LIN
DESCRIPTION
This DTC is output if communication between the transponder key ECU and power source control ECU is
not possible.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Communication between transponder key
ECU and power source control ECU is not
possible
B2785
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Wire harness
Power source control ECU
Transponder key ECU
EI
WIRING DIAGRAM
Power Source Control ECU
LIN1
Transponder Key ECU
LIN1
B126100E01
EI–82
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TRANSPONDER KEY ECU - POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU)
(a) Reconnect the T5 and P6 ECU connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Transponder Key ECU
Tester Connection
EI
T5
1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8 9
Specified Condition
T5-14 (LIN1) - P6-30 (LIN1)
Below 1 Ω
T5-14 (LIN1) or P6-30 (LIN1) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
NG
LIN1
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
Power Source Control ECU
P6
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40
LIN1
B126101E01
OK
2
CHECK TRANSPONDER KEY ECU (OPERATION)
(a) Temporarily replace the transponder key ECU with a new
or normally functioning one.
(b) Check that the power switch can be turned ON (ACC
and IG) and the hybrid control system can be started.
OK:
Power switch can be turned ON (ACC and IG) and
hybrid control system can be started.
NG
OK
END (TRANSPONDER KEY ECU IS DEFECTIVE)
REPLACE POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
DTC
B2793
EI–83
Transponder Chip Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
This DTC is output when: 1) during key code registration, a key malfunction occurs; or 2) the key code
was unable to be registered properly. Follow the inspection procedure below.
DTC No.
B2793
DTC Detection Condition
Transponder chip malfunction
Trouble Area
Key (door control transmitter)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
EI
1
REREGISTER KEY
(a) Delete the DTC (see page EI-69).
(b) Reregister the key (which caused this DTC to be output)
with the transponder key ECU (see page EI-54).
(c) Insert the same key into the key slot.
(d) Check that the power switch can be turned ON (ACC
and IG) and the hybrid control system can be started.
OK:
Power switch can be turned (ACC and IG) and
hybrid control system can be started.
NG
OK
END
REPLACE KEY
EI–84
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
DTC
B2794
Unmatched Encryption Code
DESCRIPTION
This DTC is output when a key with an incomplete key code is inserted into the key slot.
DTC No.
B2794
DTC Detection Condition
Key with incomplete key code is inserted
Trouble Area
Key (door control transmitter)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
EI
1
REREGISTER KEY
(a) Delete the DTC (see page EI-69).
(b) Reregister the key (which caused this DTC to be output)
with the transponder key ECU (see page EI-54).
(c) Insert the same key into the key slot.
(d) Check that the power switch can be turned ON (ACC
and IG) and the hybrid control system can be started.
OK:
Power switch can be turned (ACC and IG) and
hybrid control system can be started.
NG
OK
END
REPLACE KEY
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
DTC
B2795
EI–85
Unmatched Key Code
DESCRIPTION
This DTC is output when a key with a key code that has not been registered in the ECU is inserted into the
key slot.
DTC No.
B2795
DTC Detection Condition
Key with unregistered code is inserted
Trouble Area
Key (door control transmitter)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
EI
1
REREGISTER KEY
(a) Delete the DTC (see page EI-69).
(b) Reregister the key (which caused this DTC to be output)
with the transponder key ECU (see page EI-54).
(c) Insert the same key into the key slot.
(d) Check that the power switch can be turned ON (ACC
and IG) and the hybrid control system can be started.
OK:
Power switch can be turned (ACC and IG) and
hybrid control system can be started.
NG
OK
END
REPLACE KEY
EI–86
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
DTC
B2796
No Communication in Immobiliser System
DTC
B2798
Communication Malfunction No. 2
DESCRIPTION
When a key is inserted into the key slot but no communication occurs between the key and transponder
key ECU, DTC B2796 is output. When a key is inserted into the key slot but a communication error occurs
between the key and transponder key ECU, DTC B2798 is output.
DTC No.
EI
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B2796
No communication
•
•
•
•
Key (door control transmitter)
Wire harness
Key slot
Transponder key ECU
B2798
Communication error
Key (door control transmitter)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Transponder Key ECU
Key Slot
Transponder Key Amplifier
ANT2
VC5
CODE
VC5
CODE
Transponder
Key Coil
TXCT
GND
ANT1
TXCT
AGND
B121682E08
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
EI–87
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM)
(a) Check the DATA LIST for proper functioning of the
engine immobiliser system.
Transponder key ECU:
Item
IMMOBILISER
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Engine immobiliser system status
/ SET or UNSET
Normal Condition
SET: No key is in key slot
UNSET: Power switch ON (IG)
Diagnostic Note
-
OK:
"UNSET" (power switch ON (IG)) appears on
screen.
OK
REPLACE TRANSPONDER KEY ECU
NG
2
CHECK DOOR CONTROL TRANSMITTER (OPERATION)
(a) Temporarily replace the door control transmitter with a
new or normally functioning one.
(b) Check that change the power switch can be turned ON
(IG).
OK:
Power switch can be turned ON (ACC and IG) and
hybrid control system can be started.
OK
END (DOOR CONTROL TRANSMITTER IS
DEFECTIVE)
NG
3
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (TRANSPONDER KEY COIL)
(a) Check the DATA LIST for proper functioning of the
transponder key coil.
Transponder key ECU:
Item
ANTENNA COIL
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Transponder key coil condition /
NORMAL or FAIL
Normal Condition
NORMAL: Transponder key coil
is normal
FAIL: Transponder key coil is
malfunctioning
Diagnostic Note
-
OK:
"NORMAL" (transponder key coil is normal) is
appears on screen.
NG
OK
REPLACE KEY SLOT
EI
EI–88
4
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TRANSPONDER KEY ECU - KEY SLOT)
(a) Disconnect the T5 ECU connector.
(b) Disconnect the K3 key slot connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Transponder Key ECU
TXCT
Tester Connection
T5-20 (VC5) - K3-1 (VC5)
AGND
EI
T5-21 (CODE) - K3-4 (CODE)
T5
1 2 3 4 5
Specified Condition
6 7 8 9
T5-6 (TXCT) - K3-5 (TXCT)
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
Below 1 Ω
T5-7 (AGND) - K3-7 (GND)
VC5
T5-20 (VC5) or K3-1 (VC5) - Body
ground
CODE
T5-21 (CODE) or K3-4 (CODE) - Body
ground
T5-6 (TXCT) or K3-5 (TXCT) - Body
ground
Key Slot
T5-7 (AGND) or K3-7 (GND) - Body
ground
NG
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
K3
VC5
10 kΩ or higher
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
GND
CODE
TXCT
B126099E01
OK
5
CHECK KEY SLOT (OPERATION)
(a) Temporarily replace the key slot with a new or normally
functioning one.
(b) Check that the power switch can be turned ON (ACC
and IG) and the hybrid control system can be started.
OK:
Power switch can be turned ON (ACC and IG) and
hybrid control system can be started.
NG
OK
END (KEY SLOT IS DEFECTIVE)
REPLACE TRANSPONDER KEY ECU
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
DTC
B2797
EI–89
Communication Malfunction No. 1
DESCRIPTION
This DTC is output when a communication error occurs between the key slot and transponder key ECU. A
possible reason for the communication error is that noise is occurring on the communication line.
Following the inspection procedure below.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Key has noise occurring on communication
line
B2797
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
Key (door control transmitter)
Wire harness
Key slot
Transponder key ECU
EI
WIRING DIAGRAM
Key Slot
CODE
Transponder Key ECU
CODE
B121683E05
EI–90
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK TRANSPONDER KEY ECU
(a) Using an oscilloscope or the intelligent tester, check for
noise in the waveform between the terminals of the K3
key slot connector and T5 ECU connector.
OK:
No noise is present (see illustration).
Transponder Key ECU
EI
9 8 7 6
5 4 3 2 1
24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10
T5
CODE
7 6 5 4 3 2 1
CODE
Noise should
not appear.
B126102E01
OK
Tool Setting
T21-15 (CODE) T20-4 (CODE)
NG
Key Slot
K3
Tester
Connection
5 V/DIV., 20
msec./DIV.
Condition
Key inserted
Specified
Condition
No noise is
present
FIND CAUSE OF NOISE AND REMOVE IT
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
2
EI–91
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TRANSPONDER KEY ECU - KEY SLOT)
(a) Disconnect the T5 ECU connector.
(b) Disconnect the K3 key slot connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Transponder Key ECU
Tester Connection
T21-5 (CODE) - K3-4 (CODE)
T5
1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8 9
NG
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
CODE
Key Slot
K3
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
CODE
B126099E02
OK
3
CHECK KEY SLOT (OPERATION)
(a) Temporarily replace the key slot with a new or normally
functioning one.
(b) Check that the power switch can be turned ON (ACC
and IG) and the hybrid control system can be started.
OK:
Power switch can be turned ON (ACC and IG) and
hybrid control system can be turned.
NG
OK
END (KEY SLOT IS DEFECTIVE)
REPLACE TRANSPONDER KEY ECU
EI
EI–92
EI
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
DTC
B2799-539 Engine Immobiliser System Malfunction
DTC
B2799-540 Engine Immobiliser System Malfunction
DTC
B2799-541 Engine Immobiliser System Malfunction
DTC
B2799-542 Engine Immobiliser System Malfunction
DTC
B2799-543 Engine Immobiliser System Malfunction
DTC
B2799-544 Engine Immobiliser System Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
These DTCs are detected when: 1) the wire harness between the transponder key ECU and hybrid
vehicle control ECU is open or shorted, 2) the ECU communication IDs of the hybrid vehicle control ECU
and transponder key ECU are different, 3) the start ON (READY) signal is delayed, or 4) the key codes
are unmatched.
Before troubleshooting for these DTCs, make sure no transponder key ECU DTCs are present. If present,
troubleshoot the transponder key ECU DTCs or hybrid vehicle control ECU DTCs first.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
When any of the following conditions are met:
• Wire harness between transponder key
ECU and hybrid vehicle control ECU is
open or short
• ECU communication IDs of hybrid vehicle
control ECU and transponder key ECU
are different
• ON (READY) signal is delayed more than
10 seconds from when power switch is
turned to ON (READY)
• Key codes are unmatched
B2799-539
B2799-540
B2799-541
B2799-542
B2799-543
B2799-544
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Wire harness
Transponder key ECU
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
Hybrid Vehicle Control ECU
Transponder Key ECU
IMI
HEV0
IMO
HEV1
B121684E08
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
EI–93
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Delete the DTC (see page EI-69).
(b) Check that no DTC is output.
OK:
DTC is not output.
OK
END
EI
NG
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TRANSPONDER KEY ECU - HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU)
(a) Disconnect the T5 and H14 ECU connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Tester Connection
Transponder Key ECU
T5-19 (HEV0) - H14-18 (IMI)
T5-18 (HEV1) - H14-26 (IMO)
1 2 3 4 5
T5
T5-19 (HEV0) or H14-18 (IMI) - Body
ground
6 7 8 9
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
T5-18 (HEV1) or H14-26 (IMO) - Body
ground
HEV1
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
10 kΩ or higher
HEV0
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
Hybrid Vehicle Control ECU
H14
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8 9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
IMI
18 19 20 21 22 23
24 25
26 27
30 31
28 29
IMO
B126103E01
OK
3
CHECK TRANSPONDER KEY ECU (OPERATION)
(a) Temporarily replace the transponder key ECU with a new
or normally functioning one.
(b) Check that the power switch can be turned ON (ACC
and IG) and the hybrid control system can be started.
EI–94
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
OK:
Power switch can be turned ON (ACC and IG) and
hybrid control system can be started.
NG
OK
END (TRANSPONDER KEY ECU IS DEFECTIVE)
EI
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
EI–95
Power Source Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This circuit provides power to operate the transponder key ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Transponder Key ECU
P CON MAIN
CPUB
P/I
AM2
IG2
IGN
IG
to Power Source Control ECU
MAIN
GND
B126104E02
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK POWER SWITCH (OPERATION)
(a) Check that the power switch can be turned.
HINT:
• Without depressing the brake pedal, push the power
switch repeatedly. Power switch should change as
following: OFF→ ON (ACC) → ON (IG) → OFF.
EI
EI–96
ENGINE IMMOBILISER – ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o Smart Key System)
• With depressing the brake pedal, push the power
switch repeatedly. Power switch should change as
following: OFF→ ON (ACC) → ON (IG) → ON
(READY) → OFF.
NG
GO TO SMART KEY SYSTEM (for Starting)
OK
2
INSPECT FUSE (IGN, P CON MAIN, AM2)
EI
(a) Remove the IGN fuse from the instrument panel junction
block.
(b) Remove the P CON MAIN and AM2 fuses from the
engine room junction block.
(c) Measure the resistance of the fuses.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE FUSE
OK
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TRANSPONDER KEY ECU - BATTERY AND BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the T5 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance and voltage of the wire harness
side connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Tester Connection
CPUB
IG
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
T5-22 (GND) - Body ground
Standard voltage
T5
1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8 9
Tester Connection
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
T5-4 (IG) - Body ground
GND
T5-3 (CPUB) - Body
ground
B126105E01
NG
Condition
Specified Condition
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
Power switch OFF
Below 1 V
Always
10 to 14 V
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE
EM–1
ENGINE
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT AIR CLEANER FILTER ELEMENT
(a) Remove the air filter.
(b) Visually check that the air filter is not excessively
damaged or oily.
If necessary, replace the air filter.
2.
INSPECT IGNITION TIMING
(a) Set the vehicle to inspection mode (see page IN34).
(b) Warm up the engine.
(c) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(e) Select the following items:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST /
PRIMARY / IGN ADVANCE
Standard ignition timing:
8 to 12° @ BTDC
NOTICE:
• Turn all the electrical systems OFF.
• Inspect the engine idle speed with the cooling
fan OFF.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual if
you need help selecting the DATA LIST.
(f) Check that the ignition timing advances immediately
when the engine speed is increased.
Intelligent Tester
CAN VIM
DLC3
A087542E04
3.
INSPECT ENGINE IDLE SPEED
(a) Set the vehicle to inspection mode (see page IN34).
(b) Warm up the engine.
(c) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(e) Select the following items:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST /
PRIMARY / ENGINE SPD
Standard idle speed:
950 to 1,050 rpm (P range)
NOTICE:
• Turn all the electrical systems OFF.
• Inspect the engine idle speed with the cooling
fan OFF.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual if
you need help selecting the DATA LIST.
Intelligent Tester
CAN VIM
DLC3
A087542E04
4.
INSPECT COMPRESSION
(a) Remove the windshield wiper link (see page WW13).
(b) Remove the front cowl top panel outer.
EM
EM–2
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE
(c) Set the vehicle to inspection mode (see page IN34).
(d) Warm up the engine.
(e) Remove the air cleaner assembly.
(f) Disconnect all the fuel injector connectors.
(g) Disconnect the 4 ignition coil connectors and
remove the 4 bolts. Then remove the 4 ignition coils.
NOTICE:
If inspecting the compression with the ignition
coil connector disconnected, a DTC will be
detected. After the inspection, check the DTC.
(h) Remove all the spark plugs.
(i)
EM
SST
(j)
Connect SST (attachment) to a compression gauge.
SST 09992-00500
Install the compression gauge with SST into the
spark plug hole.
A057119E02
Intelligent Tester
CAN VIM
DLC3
A087542E04
(k) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(l) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(m) Select the following items:
DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD / HV ECU / ACTIVE
TEST / COMPRESS TEST
(n) Turn the power switch ON (IG) while depressing the
brake pedal. Then, measure the compression
pressure of each cylinder.
Standard compression pressure:
882 kPa (9.0 kgf/cm2, 128 psi)
Minimum pressure:
686 kPa (7.0 kgf/cm2, 99 psi)
Difference between each cylinder:
98 kPa (1.0 kgf/cm2, 14 psi) or less
NOTICE:
• Measure the compression pressure as
quickly as possible.
• After performing all the procedures, be sure
to clear DTCs stored in the memory. Then
check that the normal code is output.
If the compression pressure is low, pour a light coat
of engine oil into the cylinder block, and then
measure the compression pressure again.
HINT:
• If the compression increases after pouring
engine oil, the piston ring may be damaged.
• If the compression does not change after pouring
engine oil, defects may be occurring around the
valve.
(o) Install all the spark plugs.
Torque: 18 N*m (184 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
EM–3
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE
(p) Install the 4 ignition coil connectors.
Torque: 9.0 N*m (92 kgf*cm, 80 in.*lbf)
(q) Connect the 4 ignition coil connectors.
(r) Connect all the fuel injector connectors.
(s) Install the air cleaner assembly.
(t) Install the front cowl top panel outer.
(u) Install the windshield wiper link (see page WW-15).
5.
CO
Normal
Low
High
HC
High
High
High
INSPECT CO/HC
(a) Set the vehicle to inspection mode (see page IN34).
(b) Run the engine at 2,500 rpm for approximately 180
seconds.
(c) Insert a CO/HC meter testing probe at least 40 cm
(1.3 ft.) into the btailpipe during idling.
(d) Immediately check the CO/HC concentration at idle
and 2,500 rpm.
HINT:
When performing the 2 mode (2,500 rpm and idle)
test, check that the CO/HC concentration complies
with local regulations.
(e) If the CO/HC concentration does not comply with
regulations, troubleshoot in the order given below.
(1) Check the heated oxygen sensor operation
(see page ES-392).
(2) See the table below for possible causes, and
then inspect the applicable causes and repair it
if necessary.
Problems
Causes
Rough idle
1. Faulty ignition:
– Incorrect timing
– Plugs are contaminated, plugs are shorted or plug gaps are
incorrect
2. Incorrect valve clearance
3. Leaks in intake and exhaust valves
4. Leaks in cylinders
Rough idle
(Fluctuating HC reading)
1. Vacuum leaks:
– Ventilation hoses
– Intake manifold
– Throttle body
– IAC valve
– Brake booster line
2. Lean mixture causing misfire
Rough idle
(Black smoke from exhaust)
1. Restricted air filter
2. Plugged ventilation valve
3. Faulty SFI system:
– Faulty pressure regulator
– Defective ECT sensor
– Defective mass air flow meter
– Faulty ECM
– Faulty injectors
– Faulty throttle position sensor
EM
EM–4
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – DRIVE BELT
DRIVE BELT
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
NO. 1 AIR CLEANER INLET
DRIVE BELT
EM
ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
x3
x2
A129334E01
EM–5
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – DRIVE BELT
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
CHECK DRIVE BELT TENSION
(a) Using a belt tension gauge, measure the belt
tension.
Belt tension gauge:
DENSO BTG-20 (95506-00020)
Borroughs No. BT-33-73F
Standard drive belt tension
Item
A087786E01
CORRECT
New belt
99 to 121 lbf
Used belt
55 to 77lbf
HINT:
• After installing the drive belt, check that it fits
properly in the ribbed grooves. Check with your
hands to confirm that the belt has not slipped out
of the groove on the bottom of the crankshaft
pulley.
• A "new belt" is a belt which has been used less
than 5 minutes on a running engine.
• A "used belt" is a belt which has been used on a
running engine for 5 minutes or more.
• After installing a new belt, run the engine for
approximately 5 minutes and then recheck the
tension.
INCORRECT
A122295E01
Measure Point for Belt Deflection
Idler Pulley
(b) Reference:
Check the drive belt deflection.
(1) When not using a belt tension gauge, measure
the belt deflection.
Pressing force: 98 N (10 kgf, 22 lbf)
Standard belt deflection
Item
Crankshaft
Pulley
Water Pump
Pulley
A093818E02
Specified Condition
Specified Condition
New belt
9.0 to 12.0 mm (0.35 to 0.47 in.)
Used belt
11 to 15 mm (0.43 to 0.59 in.)
NOTICE:
• Check the drive belt deflection at the
specified point.
• When installing a new belt, set its tension
value as specified.
• When inspecting a belt which has been
used over 5 minutes, apply the
specification for "Used belt".
• When reinstalling a belt which has been
used over 5 minutes, adjust its deflection
and tension to the intermediate value of
each specification for "Used belt".
• Belt tension and deflection should be
checked after 2 revolutions of engine
cranking.
• When using a belt tension gauge,
confirm the accuracy by using a master
gauge first.
EM
EM–6
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – DRIVE BELT
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
2.
REMOVE NO. 1 AIR CLEANER INLET
(a) Loosen the clamp, and disconnect the air cleaner
inlet from the air cleaner case.
3.
REMOVE DRIVE BELT
(a) Loosen nut A.
(b) Turn adjust bolt B, and then release the belt tension.
(c) Remove the belt.
A086911E01
EM
A
B
A086912E01
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – DRIVE BELT
EM–7
INSTALLATION
A
1.
INSTALL DRIVE BELT
(a) Temporarily install the belt on each pulley.
2.
ADJUST DRIVE BELT TENSION
(a) Turn adjust bolt B to adjust the belt tension.
(b) Tighten nut A.
Torque: 40 N*m (408 kgf*cm, 30 ft.*lbf)
3.
CHECK DRIVE BELT TENSION (See page EM-5)
4.
CONNECT NO. 1 AIR CLEANER INLET
(a) Connect the air cleaner inlet to the air cleaner case
and tighten the clamp.
Torque: 3.0 N*m (31 kgf*cm, 27 in.*lbf)
5.
INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
B
A086912E01
A086911E01
EM
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – VALVE CLEARANCE
EM–7
VALVE CLEARANCE
ADJUSTMENT
1.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
2.
REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-4)
3.
REMOVE REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
4.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
5.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
6.
REMOVE WIPER ARM HEAD CAP
7.
REMOVE FRONT WIPER ARM LH (See page WW-13)
8.
REMOVE FRONT WIPER ARM RH (See page WW-13)
9.
REMOVE HOOD TO COWL TOP SEAL (See page
WW-13)
10. REMOVE COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER LH (See
page WW-13)
11. REMOVE COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER RH (See
page WW-13)
12. REMOVE WINDSHIELD WIPER LINK ASSEMBLY
(See page WW-13)
13. REMOVE FRONT COWL TOP PANEL OUTER (See
page FU-12)
14. REMOVE RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
(See page CO-6)
15. REMOVE AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY (See page EM28)
16. DISCONNECT BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER
RESERVOIR (See page EM-29)
17. REMOVE RESERVOIR BRACKET (See page EM-29)
18. REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVER (See page EM30)
19. INSPECT VALVE CLEARANCE
HINT:
Inspect and adjust the valve clearance when the engine
is cold.
EM
EM–8
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – VALVE CLEARANCE
(a) Set the No. 1 cylinder to TDC/compression.
(1) Turn the crankshaft pulley until its timing notch
and timing mark 0 of the chain cover are
aligned.
(2) Check that both timing marks on the camshaft
timing sprocket and camshaft timing gear are
facing upward as shown in the illustration.
If not, turn the crankshaft 1 complete revolution
(360°) and align the marks as above.
Timing Mark
EM
A092837E01
No. 1 Cylinder TDC/Compression
EX
(b) Check the valves indicated in the illustration.
(1) Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance
between the valve lifter and camshaft.
Standard valve clearance (Cold)
Item
IN
A081895E02
No. 4 Cylinder TDC/Compression
EX
0.17 to 0.23 mm (0.007 to 0.009 in.)
Exhaust
0.27 to 0.33 mm (0.011 to 0.013 in.)
(2) Record any out-of-specification valve clearance
measurements. They will be used later to
determine the required replacement adjusting
shim.
(c) Turn the crankshaft 1 complete revolution until its
timing notch and timing mark 0 of the chain cover
are aligned.
(d) Check the valves indicated in the illustration.
(1) Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance
between the valve lifter and camshaft.
Standard valve clearance (Cold)
Item
IN
A081896E02
Specified Condition
Intake
Specified Condition
Intake
0.17 to 0.23 mm (0.007 to 0.009 in.)
Exhaust
0.27 to 0.33 mm (0.011 to 0.013 in.)
(2) Record any out-of-specification valve clearance
measurements. They will be used later to
determine the required replacement adjusting
shim.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – VALVE CLEARANCE
EM–9
20. ADJUST VALVE CLEARANCE
(a) Set the No. 1 cylinder to TDC/compression.
(1) Turn the crankshaft pulley until its timing notch
and timing mark 0 of the chain cover are
aligned.
(2) Check that both timing marks on the camshaft
timing sprocket and valve timing controller
assembly are facing upward as shown in the
illustration.
If not, turn the crankshaft 1 complete revolution
(360°) and align the marks as above.
Timing Mark
EM
A092837E01
(3) Put paint marks on the timing chain where the
timing marks of the camshaft timing sprocket
and the camshaft timing gear are located.
Paint Mark
A092838E01
(b) Using an 8 mm hexagon wrench, remove the screw
plug.
A037101E03
EM–10
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – VALVE CLEARANCE
(c) Insert a screwdriver into the service hole of the
chain tensioner to hold the stopper plate of the
chain tensioner at an upward position.
HINT:
Lifting up the stopper plate of the chain tensioner
unlocks the plunger.
Plunger
Unlock
Stopper Plate
EM
A092839E01
(d) Keeping the stopper plate of the chain tensioner
lifted, slightly rotate the hexagonal lobe of the No. 2
camshaft to the right with an adjustable wrench so
the plunger of the chain tensioner is pushed.
HINT:
When the camshaft No. 2 is slightly rotated to the
right, the plunger is pushed.
Plunger
Stopper Plate
A092840E02
(e) Keeping the adjustable wrench installed, remove
the screwdriver with the plunger pushed.
NOTICE:
Do not move the adjustable wrench.
HINT:
Removing the screwdriver lowers the stopper plate
and locks the plunger.
Plunger
Lock
Stopper Plate
A092841E01
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – VALVE CLEARANCE
EM–11
(f)
Insert a 3.0 mm (0.118 in.) diameter bar into the
hole of the stopper plate with the stopper plate of
the chain tensioner lowered and locked.
HINT:
If a 3.0 mm (0.118 in.) diameter bar cannot be
inserted into the hole of the stopper plate, rotate the
No. 2 camshaft slightly to the left and right. Then a
3.0 mm (0.118 in.) diameter bar can be inserted
easily.
(g) Secure the 3.0 mm (0.118 in.) diameter bar with
tape.
Stopper Plate
EM
A092842E01
(h) Hold the hexagonal lobe of the camshaft No. 2 with
the adjustable wrench.
(i) Using SST, loosen the bolt.
SST 09023-38400
SST
A050157E01
(j)
1
3
5
4
2
Using several steps, uniformly loosen and remove
the 11 bearing cap bolts in the sequence shown in
the illustration. Then remove the 5 bearing caps.
NOTICE:
Loosen each bolt uniformly, keeping the
camshaft level.
A035760E02
(k) Remove the flange bolt with the No. 2 camshaft
lifted up. Then detach the No. 2 camshaft and the
camshaft timing sprocket.
A037148E01
EM–12
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – VALVE CLEARANCE
(l)
2
4
3
Using several steps, uniformly loosen and remove
the 8 bearing cap bolts in the sequence shown in
the illustration. Then remove the 4 bearing caps.
NOTICE:
Loosen each bolt uniformly, keeping the
camshaft level.
1
A035766E02
(m) Hold the timing chain with one hand, and remove
the camshaft and the camshaft timing gear
assembly.
EM
A035767E01
(n) Tie the timing chain with a string as shown in the
illustration.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to drop anything inside the timing
chain cover.
A035227E01
(o) Remove the valve lifters.
(p) Using a micrometer, measure the thickness of the
removed lifter.
(q) Calculate the thickness of a new lifter so that the
valve clearance comes within the specified value.
A
New lifter thickness
B
Used lifter thickness
C
Measured valve clearance
New lifter thickness
A001082E01
Item
Thickness
Intake
A = B + (C - 0.20 mm (0.008 in.))
Exhaust
A = B + (C - 0.30 mm (0.012 in.))
(r)
Select a new lifter with the thickness as close to the
calculated values as possible.
EXAMPLE: (Intake)
Measured valve clearance = 0.40 mm (0.0158 in.)
0.40 mm (0.0158 in.) - 0.20 mm (0.0079 in.) = 0.20
mm (0.0079 in.)
(Measured - Specification = Excess clearance)
Used lifter measurement = 5.25 mm (0.2067 in.)
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – VALVE CLEARANCE
EM–13
0.20 mm (0.0079 in.) + 5.25 mm (0.2067 in.) = 5.45
mm (0.2146 in.)
(Excess clearance + Used lifter = Ideal new lifter)
Closest new lifter = 5.45 mm (0.2146 in.)
Select No. 46 lifter (5.46 mm (0.2150 in.))
HINT:
• Lifters are available in 35 sizes in increments of
0.020 mm (0.0008 in.), from 5.060 mm (0.1992
in.) to 5.740 mm (0.2260 in.).
• Refer to the New lifter thickness table below.
EM
EM–14
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – VALVE CLEARANCE
(1) Valve lifter selection chart (intake)
Measured Clearance mm (in.)
Installed Lifter Thickness mm (in.)
EM
A116733E01
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – VALVE CLEARANCE
EM–15
(2) Valve lifter selection chart (intake) (continued).
Measured Clearance mm (in.)
Installed Lifter Clearance mm (in.)
EM
A116734E01
New lifter thickness
Lifter No.
Thickness
Lifter No.
Thickness
Lifter No.
Thickness
06
5.060 mm (0.1992 in.)
30
5.300 mm (0.2087 in.)
54
5.540 mm (0.2181 in.)
08
5.080 mm (0.2000 in.)
32
5.320 mm (0.2094 in.)
56
5.560 mm (0.2189 in.)
EM–16
Lifter No.
EM
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – VALVE CLEARANCE
Thickness
Lifter No.
Thickness
Lifter No.
Thickness
10
5.100 mm (0.2008 in.)
34
5.340 mm (0.2102 in.)
58
5.580 mm (0.2197 in.)
12
5.120 mm (0.2016 in.)
36
5.360 mm (0.2110 in.)
60
5.600 mm (0.2205 in.)
14
5.140 mm (0.2024 in.)
38
5.380 mm (0.2118 in.)
62
5.620 mm (0.2213 in.)
16
5.160 mm (0.2031 in.)
40
5.400 mm (0.2126 in.)
64
5.640 mm (0.2220 in.)
18
5.180 mm (0.2039 in.)
42
5.420 mm (0.2134 in.)
66
5.660 mm (0.2228 in.)
20
5.200 mm (0.2047 in.)
44
5.440 mm (0.2142 in.)
68
5.680 mm (0.2236 in.)
22
5.220 mm (0.2055 in.)
46
5.460 mm (0.2150 in.)
70
5.700 mm (0.2244 in.)
24
5.240 mm (0.2063 in.)
48
5.480 mm (0.2157 in.)
72
5.720 mm (0.2252 in.)
26
5.260 mm (0.2071 in.)
50
5.500 mm (0.2165 in.)
74
5.740 mm (0.2260 in.)
28
5.280 mm (0.2079 in.)
52
5.520 mm (0.2173 in.)
-
-
Standard intake valve clearance (Cold):
0.17 to 0.23 mm (0.007 to 0.009 in.)
EXAMPLE:
A 5.250 mm (0.2067 in.) lifter is installed, and
the measured clearance is 0.400 mm (0.0158
in.).
Replace the 5.250 mm (0.2067 in.) lifter with a
new No. 46 lifter.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – VALVE CLEARANCE
EM–17
(3) Valve lifter selection chart (exhaust).
Measured Clearance mm (in.)
Installed Lifter Thickness mm (in.)
EM
A130303E01
EM–18
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – VALVE CLEARANCE
(4) Valve selection chart (exhaust) (continued).
Measured Clearance mm (in.)
Installed Lifter Clearance mm (in.)
EM
A116736E01
New lifter thickness
Lifter No.
Thickness
Lifter No.
Thickness
Lifter No.
Thickness
06
5.060 mm (0.1992 in.)
30
5.300 mm (0.2087 in.)
54
5.540 mm (0.2181 in.)
08
5.080 mm (0.2000 in.)
32
5.320 mm (0.2094 in.)
56
5.560 mm (0.2189 in.)
EM–19
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – VALVE CLEARANCE
Lifter No.
Thickness
Lifter No.
Thickness
Lifter No.
Thickness
10
5.100 mm (0.2008 in.)
34
5.340 mm (0.2102 in.)
58
5.580 mm (0.2197 in.)
12
5.120 mm (0.2016 in.)
36
5.360 mm (0.2110 in.)
60
5.600 mm (0.2205 in.)
14
5.140 mm (0.2024 in.)
38
5.380 mm (0.2118 in.)
62
5.620 mm (0.2213 in.)
16
5.160 mm (0.2031 in.)
40
5.400 mm (0.2126 in.)
64
5.640 mm (0.2220 in.)
18
5.180 mm (0.2039 in.)
42
5.420 mm (0.2134 in.)
66
5.660 mm (0.2228 in.)
20
5.200 mm (0.2047 in.)
44
5.440 mm (0.2142 in.)
68
5.680 mm (0.2236 in.)
22
5.220 mm (0.2055 in.)
46
5.460 mm (0.2150 in.)
70
5.700 mm (0.2244 in.)
24
5.240 mm (0.2063 in.)
48
5.480 mm (0.2157 in.)
72
5.720 mm (0.2252 in.)
26
5.260 mm (0.2071 in.)
50
5.500 mm (0.2165 in.)
74
5.740 mm (0.2260 in.)
28
5.280 mm (0.2079 in.)
52
5.520 mm (0.2173 in.)
-
-
Standard exhaust valve clearance (Cold):
0.27 to 0.33 mm (0.011 to 0.013 in.)
EXAMPLE:
A 5.340 mm (0.2102 in.) lifter is installed, and
the measured clearance is 0.440 mm (0.0173
in.).
Replace the 5.340 mm (0.2102 in.) lifter with a
new No. 48 lifter.
(s) Reinstall the selected valve lifters.
(t) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the camshaft
journals.
Paint Mark
(u) Install the timing chain onto the camshaft timing
gear with the paint mark and the timing mark
aligned as shown in the illustration.
Timing Mark
A130317E01
(v) Examine the front marks and numbers, and tighten
the bolts in the sequence shown in the illustration.
Torque: 13 N*m (130 kgf*cm, 9.6 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Tighten each bolt uniformly, keeping the
camshaft level.
3
1
2
4
A037107E02
EM
EM–20
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – VALVE CLEARANCE
Paint Mark
(w) Hold the timing chain, and align the timing mark on
the camshaft timing sprocket with the paint mark of
the timing chain.
Timing Mark
A092844E02
(x) Align the alignment pin hole on the camshaft timing
sprocket with the alignment pin of the camshaft, and
install the sprocket into the camshaft.
(y) Temporarily install the timing sprocket bolt.
EM
A037148E01
5
3
1
2
(z) Examine the front marks and numbers, and tighten
the bolts in the sequence shown in the illustration.
Torque: 13 N*m (133 kgf*cm, 9 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Tighten each bolt uniformly, keeping the
camshaft level.
(aa) Install the No. 1 bearing cap.
Torque: 23 N*m (235 kgf*cm, 17 ft.*lbf)
4
No. 1 Bearing Cap
A092845E02
(ab) Hold the hexagonal lobe of the No. 2 camshaft with
the adjustable wrench.
(ac) Using SST, tighten the bolt.
SST 09023-38400
Torque: 64 N*m (653 kgf*cm, 47 ft.*lbf)
SST
A050157E01
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – VALVE CLEARANCE
EM–21
(ad) Remove the bar from the timing chain tensioner.
EM
A089861E01
(ae) Turn the crankshaft pulley until its timing notch and
timing mark 0 of the chain cover are aligned.
(af) Check that all the pairs of the timing marks are
aligned.
Timing Mark
A092837E01
(ag) Apply seal packing to 2 or 3 threads of the screw
plug end.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Adhesive 1324, Three Bond
1324 or Equivalent
Adhesive
A058128E03
(ah) Using an 8 mm hexagon wrench, install the screw
plug.
Torque: 15 N*m (153 kgf*cm, 11 ft.*lbf)
21. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVER (See page EM-39)
22. INSTALL RESERVOIR BRACKET (See page EM-40)
23. INSTALL BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER RESERVOIR
(See page EM-40)
A037101E03
24. INSTALL AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY (See page EM41)
EM–22
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – VALVE CLEARANCE
25. INSTALL FRONT COWL TOP PANEL OUTER (See
page FU-19)
26. INSTALL WINDSHIELD WIPER LINK ASSEMBLY (See
page WW-16)
27. INSTALL COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER RH
28. INSTALL COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER LH
29. INSTALL HOOD TO COWL TOP SEAL
30. INSTALL FRONT WIPER ARM LH (See page WW-16)
31. INSTALL FRONT WIPER ARM RH (See page WW-16)
32. INSTALL WIPER ARM HEAD CAP
EM
33. CHECK ENGINE OIL LEAKS
34. INSTALL RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
(See page CO-9)
35. REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
36. CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL (See page CH-7)
37. INSTALL REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
38. INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-8)
39. INSTALL NO. 2 REAR FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
40. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
EM–23
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – TIMING CHAIN
TIMING CHAIN
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
x6
AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
7.0 (71, 62 in.*lbf)
WIRE HARNESS
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
RADIATOR SUPPORT
OPENING COVER
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
EM
x2
3.0 (31, 27 in.*lbf)
CLAMP
WINDSHIELD WASHER
JAR ASSEMBLY
x2
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
x3
NO. 2 AIR
CLEANER INLET
BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER
RESERVOIR COVER
BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER
RESERVOIR
8.5 (87, 75 in.*lbf)
RESERVOIR BRACKET
4.9 (50, 43 in.*lbf)
PURGE VSV
14 (143, 10)
x3
x2
ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
x3 x2
x4
A124494E01
EM–24
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – TIMING CHAIN
WINDSHIELD WIPER ARM COVER
FRONT WIPER ARM RH
FRONT WIPER ARM LH
21 (56, 16)
21 (56, 16)
x2
HOOD TO COWL TOP SEAL
EM
COWL TOP VENTILATOR
LOUVER LH
COWL TOP
VENTILATOR
LOUVER RH
x5
WIPER MOTOR CONNECTOR
8.4 (86, 74 in.*lbf)
WINDSHIELD
MOTOR WITH
WIPER LINK
ASSEMBLY
FRONT COWL TOP PANEL OUTER
6.4 (65, 57 in.*lbf)
NO. 2 ENGINE ROOM
RELAY BLOCK
x2
8.4 (86, 74 in.*lbf)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A124444E05
EM–25
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – TIMING CHAIN
10 (102, 7.4)
10 (102, 7.4)
x4
10 (102, 7.4)
IGNITION COIL
10 (102, 7.4)
x4
x2
x7
x2
VENTILATION HOSE
EM
CYLINDER HEAD COVER
NO. 2 VENTILATION HOSE
GASKET
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A124495E01
EM–26
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – TIMING CHAIN
52 (530, 38)
52 (530, 38)
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
ENGINE MOUNTING
INSULATOR RH
EM
CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL
CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY
ENGINE MOUNTING
BRACKET
55 (560, 41)
52 (530, 38)
CRANKSHAFT
POSITION
SENSOR
24 (245, 18)
STUD BOLT
32 (326, 24)
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
24 (245, 18)
x2
11 (112, 8.1)
STRAIGHT PIN
x 11
128 (1,305, 95)
OIL PUMP SEAL
CRANKSHAFT PULLEY
O-RING
11 (112, 8.1)
TIMING CHAIN COVER
11 (112, 8.1)
x3
GASKET
x2
DRIVE BELT
15 (153, 11)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
WATER PUMP
11 (112, 8.1)
WATER PUMP PULLEY
Non-reusable part
Grease application
A124496E01
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – TIMING CHAIN
EM–27
NO. 1 CHAIN TENSIONER
CHAIN TENSIONER SLIPPER
EM
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
CHAIN
NO. 1 CHAIN VIBRATION DAMPER
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A124497E01
EM–28
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – TIMING CHAIN
REMOVAL
EM
1.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
2.
REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-4)
3.
REMOVE REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
4.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
5.
REMOVE RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
6.
REMOVE FRONT WHEELS
7.
REMOVE NO. 3 ENGINE UNDER COVER
8.
REMOVE NO. 4 CENTER ENGINE UNDER COVER
9.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-6)
10. DRAIN ENGINE OIL (See page LU-4)
11. REMOVE WIPER ARM HEAD CAP
12. REMOVE FRONT WIPER ARM LH (See page WW-13)
13. REMOVE FRONT WIPER ARM RH (See page WW-13)
14. REMOVE HOOD TO COWL TOP SEAL (See page
WW-13)
15. REMOVE COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER LH (See
page WW-13)
16. REMOVE COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER RH (See
page WW-13)
17. REMOVE WINDSHIELD MOTOR WITH WIPER LINK
ASSEMBLY (See page WW-13)
18. REMOVE FRONT COWL TOP PANEL OUTER (See
page FU-12)
19. REMOVE AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
(a) Loosen the clamp, then disconnect the No. 1 air
cleaner inlet from the air cleaner case.
A086911E01
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – TIMING CHAIN
EM–29
(b) Disconnect the intake air flow meter connector, then
remove the wire harness clamp.
(c) Loosen the clamp, then remove the 2 bolts and air
cleaner assembly.
A087334E01
20. REMOVE NO. 2 AIR CLEANER INLET
(a) Remove the clip and No. 2 air cleaner inlet.
EM
A087335E01
A087336E01
21. DISCONNECT BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER
RESERVOIR
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts.
(c) Separate the claw fitting, then suspend the brake
master cylinder reservoir with rope.
NOTICE:
Be careful of the angle of the brake master
cylinder reservoir when suspending to prevent
air from coming into the hose.
22. REMOVE RESERVOIR BRACKET
(a) Disconnect the hose from the brake master cylinder
reservoir bracket.
(b) Remove the 3 bolts and wire harness clamp, then
remove the brake master cylinder reservoir bracket.
A087337E01
23. REMOVE WINDSHIELD WASHER JAR ASSEMBLY
(a) Loosen the bolt which holds the headlight RH.
(b) Disconnect the connector and remove the wire
harness clamp.
(c) Remove the bolt and bracket.
A087338E01
EM–30
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – TIMING CHAIN
(d) Remove the nut.
(e) Slightly lift the headlight RH and separate the claw
fitting, then remove the washer jar assembly.
(f) Disconnect the hose from the washer jar assembly.
A087339E01
24. REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVER
(a) Disconnect the fuel injector connector and ignition
coil connector.
(b) Remove the 3 bolts and wire harness clamp, then
disconnect the wire harness.
EM
A087340E01
(c) Remove the brake master cylinder reservoir cover.
A087341E01
(d) Disconnect the ventilation hose and ventilation hose
No. 2.
A087343E01
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – TIMING CHAIN
EM–31
(e) Remove the bolt and ignition coil.
A087344E01
(f)
Remove the 9 bolts and 2 nuts, then remove the
cylinder head cover.
EM
A066472E01
25. REMOVE PURGE VSV
(a) Disconnect the connector and hose.
(b) Remove the bolt and purge VSV.
26. REMOVE DRIVE BELT (See page EM-6)
27. REMOVE WATER PUMP (See page CO-11)
A087345E01
28. REMOVE CRANKSHAFT PULLEY
(a) Using SST, hold the crankshaft pulley and loosen
the crankshaft bolt.
SST 09213-58013 (91111-50845), 09330-00021
NOTICE:
When installing SST, be careful that the bolt
which holds SST does not interfere with the
chain cover.
SST
A092650E01
(b) Loosen the crankshaft bolt until 2 to 3 threads of the
bolt are tightened to the crankshaft.
(c) Using SST, remove the crankshaft damper.
SST 09950-50013 (09951-05010, 09952-05010,
09953-05020, 09954-05021)
(d) Remove the crankshaft bolt.
SST
A092651E01
EM–32
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – TIMING CHAIN
29. REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR RH
(a) Put a wooden block on a jack. Support the oil pan
with the jack.
A087348E01
(b) Remove the 3 bolts and 4 nuts, then remove the
engine mounting insulator RH.
EM
A087349E01
30. REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING SPACER
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and engine mounting spacer.
A087350E01
31. REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and engine mounting bracket.
A087351E01
32. REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE
ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the bolt and camshaft timing oil control
valve assembly.
33. REMOVE CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (See
page ES-443)
34. REMOVE TIMING CHAIN COVER (See page LU-15)
A087352E01
35. REMOVE OIL PUMP SEAL (See page EM-138)
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – TIMING CHAIN
EM–33
36. SET NO. 1 CYLINDER TO TDC / COMPRESSION
(a) Install the washer to the crankshaft bolt, then install
the bolt to the crankshaft.
(b) Turn the crankshaft clockwise so it is positioned as
illustrated.
Timing Mark
Timing Mark
EM
A093711E02
37. REMOVE NO. 1 CHAIN TENSIONER
(a) Lift up the stopper plate, then unlock the plunger.
(b) Push in the plunger to the end with the plunger
unlocked.
Plunger
Unlock
Stopper Plate
A092824E01
(c) Lower the stopper plate with the plunger pushed to
the end, then lock the plunger.
Plunger
Stopper Plate
Lock
A092825E01
(d) Insert a 3.0 mm (0.118 in.) diameter bar into the
hole of the stopper plate with the plunger locked.
HINT:
If the stopper plate is not completely lowered and a
3.0 mm (0.118 in.) diameter bar cannot be inserted,
unlock and pull out the plunger slightly. Then the
stopper plate will be completely lowered and a 3.0
mm (0.118 in.) diameter bar can be inserted easily.
A087621E01
EM–34
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – TIMING CHAIN
(e) Remove the 2 bolts and chain tensioner.
A089044E01
38. REMOVE CHAIN TENSIONER SLIPPER
(a) Remove the bolt and tensioner slipper.
EM
A088883E02
39. REMOVE NO. 1 CHAIN VIBRATION DAMPER
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and chain vibration damper.
A088884E01
40. REMOVE CHAIN
(a) Remove the chain from the engine.
A088885E01
INSPECTION
1.
Measuring Area
01234 5
16
A050062E01
INSPECT CHAIN
(a) Using a spring scale, pull the timing chain with a
force of 140 N (14.3 kgf, 31.5 lbf) and measure the
length of it.
Maximum chain elongation:
124.2 mm (4.890 in.)
If the elongation is greater than the maximum,
replace the chain.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – TIMING CHAIN
EM–35
HINT:
Perform the measurements at 3 or more random
places to obtain the average length.
2.
INSPECT NO. 1 CHAIN TENSIONER
(a) Check that the plunger moves smoothly when the
ratchet pawl is raised with your finger.
(b) Release the ratchet pawl and check that the plunger
is locked in place by the ratchet pawl and does not
move when pushed with your finger.
3.
INSPECT CHAIN TENSIONER SLIPPER
(a) Measure the chain tensioner slipper wear.
Maximum wear:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
If the wear is greater than the maximum, replace the
slipper.
4.
INSPECT NO. 1 CHAIN VIBRATION DAMPER
(a) Measure the vibration damper wear.
Maximum wear:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
If the wear is greater than the maximum, replace the
damper.
A011223E02
A037065E01
A037066E01
EM
EM–36
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – TIMING CHAIN
INSTALLATION
1.
40q
Timing Mark
INSTALL CHAIN
(a) Set the position of the No. 1 cylinder to 20° ATDC.
NOTICE:
To prevent the pistons from hitting against
valves, the following procedures must be
performed in the order below.
(1) Set the crankshaft between 40 to 140° ATDC.
(2) Set the cams of the intake and exhaust timing
sprockets to 20° ATDC.
(3) Reset the crankshaft to 20° ATDC.
(b) Install the chain vibration damper with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 9.0 N*m (92 kgf*cm, 80 in.*lbf)
EM
A092826E01
20° ATDC
(c) Align the timing marks of the camshaft timing
sprocket, camshaft timing gear and crankshaft
timing sprocket with each mark plate (colored in
yellow) of the timing chain.
HINT:
To prevent the exhaust camshaft from springing
back, turn it using a wrench and set it at the mark on
the chain.
Mark Plate
Timing Mark
Mark Plate
Timing Mark
30°
A081877E03
(d) Install the chain tensioner slipper with the bolt.
Torque: 9.0 N*m (92 kgf*cm, 80 in.*lbf)
A088883E02
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – TIMING CHAIN
EM–37
(e) Install the chain tensioner with the 2 bolts.
(1) Lift up the stopper plate, then unlock the
plunger.
(2) Push in the plunger to the end with the plunger
unlocked.
Plunger
Unlock
Stopper Plate
A092824E01
(3) Lower the stopper plate with the plunger
pushed to the end, then lock the plunger.
Plunger
EM
Stopper Plate
Lock
A092825E01
(4) Insert a 3.0 mm (0.118 in.) diameter bar into the
hole of the stopper plate with the plunger
locked.
Plunger
Stopper Plate
A080976E02
HINT:
If the stopper plate is not completely lowered
and a 3.0 mm (0.118 in.) diameter bar cannot
be inserted, unlock and pull out the plunger
slightly. Then the stopper plate will be
completely lowered and a 3.0 mm (0.118 in.)
diameter bar can be inserted easily.
A087621E01
(f)
A089044E01
(5) Install the chain tensioner with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 9.0 N*m (92 kgf*cm, 80 in.*lbf)
(6) Remove the bar from the chain tensioner.
Check the tension between the intake and exhaust
camshaft timing sprockets.
2.
INSTALL OIL PUMP SEAL (See page LU-17)
3.
INSTALL TIMING CHAIN COVER (See page LU-19)
4.
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (See
page ES-443)
EM–38
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – TIMING CHAIN
5.
INSTALL CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE
ASSEMBLY (See page ES-438)
6.
INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET
(a) Install the engine mounting bracket with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 55 N*m (561 kgf*cm, 41 in.*lbf)
7.
INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING SPACER
(a) Install the engine mounting spacer with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 55 N*m (561 kgf*cm, 41 in.*lbf)
8.
INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR RH
(a) Install the engine mounting insulator RH with the 3
bolts and 4 nuts.
Torque: 52 N*m (530 kgf*cm, 38 in.*lbf)
9.
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT PULLEY
(a) Align the hole of the crankshaft damper with the
straight pin, then install the crankshaft damper.
(b) Using SST, hold the crankshaft damper and tighten
the crankshaft bolt.
SST 09213-58013 (91111-50845), 09330-00021
Torque: 128 N*m (1,305 kgf*cm, 95 in.*lbf)
NOTICE:
When installing SST, be careful that the bolt
which holds SST does not interfere with the
chain cover.
A087351E01
EM
A087350E01
A089869E01
SST
A092652E01
10. INSTALL WATER PUMP (See page CO-11)
11. INSTALL DRIVE BELT (See page EM-6)
12. CHECK DRIVE BELT TENSION (See page EM-6)
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – TIMING CHAIN
EM–39
13. INSTALL PURGE VSV
(a) Install the purge VSV with the bolt.
(b) Connect the hose and connector.
A087345E01
Seal Packing
11
A092514E01
9
7
5
10
1
8
3
2
6
14. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVER
(a) Apply seal packing to the 2 locations shown in the
illustration, then install the cylinder head cover.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three
Bond 1207B or Equivalent
NOTICE:
• Remove any oil from the contact surface.
• Install the cylinder head cover within 3
minutes after applying seal packing.
• Do not start the engine within 2 hours of
installing.
(b) Install the cylinder head cover with the 9 bolts and 2
nuts.
(c) Using several steps, tighten the bolts and nuts to the
specified torque in the sequence shown in the
illustration.
Torque: 10 N*m (102 kgf*cm, 74 in.*lbf)
4
A035756E02
(d) Install the ignition coil with the bolt.
Torque: 9.0 N*m (92 kgf*cm, 80 in.*lbf)
A087344E01
EM
EM–40
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – TIMING CHAIN
(e) Install the brake master cylinder reservoir cover to
the cylinder head cover.
A087341E01
(f)
Install the wire harness and brake master cylinder
reservoir cover with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 9.0 N*m (92 kgf*cm, 80 in.*lbf)
(g) Connect the fuel injector connector and ignition coil
connector.
EM
A087340E01
15. INSTALL WINDSHIELD WASHER JAR
(a) Install the windshield washer with the 2 bolts and
nut.
Torque: 4.9 N*m (50 kgf*cm, 43 in.*lbf) for bolt A
14 N*m (143 kgf*cm, 10 in.*lbf) for bolt B
5.5 N*m (56 kgf*cm, 49 in.*lbf) for nut
(b) Connect the 2 connectors and wire harness.
A
B
A092653E01
16. INSTALL RESERVOIR BRACKET
(a) Install the reservoir bracket with the 3 bolts and
connect the wire harness clamp.
Torque: 8.5 N*m (87 kgf*cm, 75 in.*lbf)
A087337E01
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – TIMING CHAIN
EM–41
17. INSTALL BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER RESERVOIR
(a) Attach the claw and install the master cylinder
reservoir with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 8.5 N*m (87 kgf*cm, 75 in.*lbf)
(b) Connect the connector.
A087336E02
18. INSTALL NO. 2 AIR CLEANER INLET
(a) Install the air cleaner inlet with the clip.
EM
A087335E01
19. INSTALL AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the air cleaner with the 2 bolts and tighten the
clamp.
Torque: 7.0 N*m (71 kgf*cm, 62 in.*lbf) for bolt
3.0 N*m (31 kgf*cm, 27 in.*lbf) for clamp
(b) Connect the MAF meter connector and clamp.
A087334E01
(c) Connect the No. 1 air inlet, and then tighten the
clamp.
20. INSTALL FRONT COWL TOP PANEL OUTER
21. INSTALL WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR AND WIPER
LINK ASSEMBLY (See page WW-16)
22. INSTALL COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER RH
23. INSTALL COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER LH
A086911E01
24. INSTALL HOOD TO COWL TOP SEAL
25. INSTALL FRONT WIPER ARM LH (See page WW-16)
26. INSTALL FRONT WIPER ARM RH (See page WW-16)
27. INSTALL WIPER ARM HEAD CAP
28. ADD ENGINE OIL (See page LU-4)
29. CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL (See page CH-7)
30. INSTALL REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
EM–42
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – TIMING CHAIN
31. INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
32. INSTALL REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
33. ADD ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-7)
34. CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS (See page
CO-2)
35. INSTALL RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
36. INSTALL NO. 4 CENTER ENGINE UNDER COVER
37. INSTALL NO. 3 ENGINE UNDER COVER
38. INSTALL FRONT WHEELS
EM
39. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
EM–43
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
CYLINDER HEAD
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
x6
AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
7.0 (71, 62 in.*lbf)
WIRE HARNESS
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
RADIATOR SUPPORT
OPENING COVER
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
EM
x2
3.0 (31, 27 in.*lbf)
WINDSHIELD WASHER
JAR ASSEMBLY
CLAMP
x2
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
x3
NO. 2 AIR
CLEANER INLET
BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER
RESERVOIR COVER
BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER RESERVOIR
8.5 (87, 75 in.*lbf)
RESERVOIR BRACKET
4.9 (50, 43 in.*lbf)
PURGE VSV
14 (143, 10)
x3
x2
ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
x3 x2
x4
A124494E02
EM–44
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
WINDSHIELD WIPER ARM COVER
FRONT WIPER ARM RH
FRONT WIPER ARM LH
21 (56, 16)
21 (56, 16)
x2
HOOD TO COWL TOP SEAL
EM
COWL TOP VENTILATION
LOUVER LH
COWL TOP
VENTILATION
LOUVER RH
x5
WIPER MOTOR CONNECTOR
8.4 (86, 74 in.*lbf)
WINDSHIELD
MOTOR WITH
WIPER LINK
ASSEMBLY
FRONT COWL TOP PANEL OUTER
6.4 (65, 57 in.*lbf)
NO. 2 ENGINE ROOM
RELAY BLOCK
x2
8.4 (86, 74 in.*lbf)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A124444E06
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
x 12
EM–45
11 (112, 8.1)
INVERTER COVER
11 (112, 8.1)
EM
NO. 2 INVERTER COOLING HOSE
NO. 1 INVERTER
COOLING HOSE
ENGINE ROOM MAIN
WIRE HARNESS
NO. 1 CIRCUIT BREAKER SENSOR
CONNECTOR
NO. 6 INVERTER COOLING HOSE
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A124445E02
EM–46
EM
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
HEATER WATER HOSE
FUEL MAIN TUBE
FUEL PIPE CLAMP
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
OIL DIPSTICK GUIDE
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
RADIATOR INLET HOSE
NO. 1 WATER BY-PASS PIPE
NO. 2 WATER BY-PASS HOSE
HEATER WATER HOSE
COMPRESSION SPRING
43 (438, 32)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
FRONT EXHAUST
PIPE ASSEMBLY
GASKET
A129335E01
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
EM–47
EM
21 (214, 16)
21 (214, 16)
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
21 (214, 16)
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
MG2 POWER CABLE
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
MG1 POWER CABLE
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A124446E03
EM–48
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
10 (102, 7.4)
10 (102, 7.4)
x4
10 (102, 7.4)
IGNITION COIL
10 (102, 7.4)
x4
x2
x7
x2
VENTILATION HOSE
EM
CYLINDER HEAD COVER
NO. 2 VENTILATION HOSE
GASKET
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A124495E02
EM–49
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
52 (530, 38)
52 (530, 38)
ENGINE MOUNTING
INSULATOR RH
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL
CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY
ENGINE MOUNTING
BRACKET
EM
55 (560, 41)
52 (530, 38)
CRANKSHAFT
POSITION
SENSOR
24 (245, 18)
STUD BOLT
32 (326, 24)
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
24 (245, 18)
x2
11 (112, 8.1)
STRAIGHT PIN
x 11
128 (1,305, 95)
OIL PUMP SEAL
CRANKSHAFT PULLEY
O-RING
11 (112, 8.1)
TIMING CHAIN COVER
11 (112, 8.1)
x3
GASKET
x2
DRIVE BELT
15 (153, 11)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
WATER PUMP
11 (112, 8.1)
WATER PUMP PULLEY
Non-reusable part
Grease application
A124496E02
EM–50
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
NO. 1 CHAIN TENSIONER
EM
CHAIN TENSIONER SLIPPER
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
CHAIN
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
NO. 1 CHAIN VIBRATION DAMPER
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A124497E03
EM–51
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
23 (235, 17)
x3
NO. 1 CAMSHAFT
BEARING CAP
x 16
x8
13 (133, 10)
NO. 2 CAMSHAFT
BEARING CAP
NO. 2 CAMSHAFT
CAMSHAFT TIMING
SPROCKET
CAMSHAFT
64 (653, 47)
CAMSHAFT
TIMING GEAR
64 (653, 47)
1st: 29 (296, 21)
2nd: 90°
3rd: 90°
EM
x 10
CYLINDER HEAD
GASKET
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A124504E01
EM–52
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
FUEL DELIVERY PIPE
19 (194, 14)
19 (194, 14)
O-RING
DELIVERY PIPE
SPACER
FUEL INJECTOR
EM
x4
INSULATOR
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
NO. 1 WATER BY-PASS PIPE
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
x3
x2
x2
27 (275, 20)
EXHAUST MANIFOLD
GASKET
GASKET
NO. 1 EXHAUST MANIFOLD
INSULATOR
CYLINDER HEAD
20 (204, 15)
x2
x3
GASKET
INTAKE MANIFOLD
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A129819E01
EM–53
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
VALVE LIFTER
VALVE SPRING RETAINER LOCK
VALVE SPRING RETAINER
VALVE SPRING
VALVE STEM OIL SEAL
VALVE SPRING SEAT
EM
INTAKE VALVE GUIDE BUSH
EXHAUST VALVE
GUIDE BUSH
CAMSHAFT BEARING
CAP SETTING RING PIN
44 (449, 33)
NO. 1 TAPER SCREW PLUG
GASKET
4.0 (41, 35 in.*lbf)
STUD BOLT
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
STUD BOLT
CYLINDER HEAD
GASKET
10 (102, 7)
STUD BOLT
30 (306, 22)
OIL CONTROL VALVE FILTER
INTAKE VALVE
EXHAUST VALVE
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A116722E02
EM–54
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
REMOVAL
EM
A087632E01
1.
DISCHARGE FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE (See page
FU-12)
2.
PRECAUTION
CAUTION:
The hybrid system uses high voltage circuits, so
improper handling could cause an electric shock or
leakage. During service (e.g. installing or removing
the parts, inspection, replacing the parts), be sure to
follow the procedures (see page HV-519).
3.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
4.
REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-4)
5.
REMOVE REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
6.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
7.
REMOVE SERVICE PLUG GRIP (See page HB-154)
8.
DISCONNECT FRONT EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and 2 compression rings, then
disconnect the exhaust pipe assembly front from the
exhaust manifold.
9.
REMOVE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the inverter with converter from the vehicle
(see page HV-530).
10. REMOVE CHAIN
(a) Remove the chain from the engine (see page EM28).
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
EM–55
11. DISCONNECT WIRE HARNESS
(a) Disconnect the connectors and wire harnesses
shown in the illustration.
EM
A087634E01
12. REMOVE FUEL MAIN TUBE
(a) Remove the fuel pipe clamp.
A087635E01
EM–56
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
(b) Disconnect the fuel tube from the fuel delivery pipe.
NOTICE:
Even if the fuel tube is stuck and cannot be
disconnected, do not use any tools. Push and
pull the parts with the quick connector pinched
to disconnect the tube.
(c) Cover the disconnected fuel tube and fuel delivery
pipe with a plastic bag in order to prevent foreign
objects from entering them.
A087636E01
13. DISCONNECT RADIATOR INLET HOSE
(a) Disconnect the radiator inlet hose from the cylinder
head.
EM
A087637E01
14. DISCONNECT HOSES
(a) Disconnect the hoses from the cylinder head as
shown in the illustration.
A087638E01
15. DISCONNECT NO. 1 WATER BY-PASS PIPE
(a) Remove the bolt and disconnect the water by-pass
pipe.
16. REMOVE OIL DIPSTICK GUIDE
(a) Disconnect the hoses shown in the illustration.
(b) Remove the bolt and disconnect the dipstick guide.
A087639E01
1
3
5
4
17. REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD
(a) Remove the No. 1 and No. 2 camshaft bearing caps
in the sequence shown in the illustration, then
remove the camshaft and No. 2 camshaft.
NOTICE:
Uniformly loosen the bolts, keeping the
camshaft level.
2
A087641E01
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
3
7
9
6
1
5
10
8
EM–57
(b) Using an 8 mm bi-hexagon wrench, loosen the
cylinder head bolts in several steps in the sequence
shown in the illustration. Then remove the cylinder
head bolts and washer.
NOTICE:
• When removing the bolt, do not drop the
washer into the engine.
• Removing the cylinder head bolts in the
wrong order may cause damage to the
cylinder head.
(c) Remove the cylinder head.
2
4
A035286E02
18. REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD GASKET
19. REMOVE INTAKE MANIFOLD (See page EM-99)
20. REMOVE EXHAUST MANIFOLD (See page EM-100)
21. REMOVE NOISE FILTER (See page EM-101)
22. REMOVE ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE
SENSOR (See page ES-445)
23. REMOVE FUEL DELIVERY PIPE (See page EM-122)
24. REMOVE FUEL INJECTOR (See page EM-123)
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE NO. 1 TAPER SCREW PLUG
(a) Using a 10 mm hexagon wrench, remove the taper
screw plug and gasket.
2.
REMOVE OIL CONTROL VALVE FILTER
(a) Using an 8 mm hexagon wrench, remove the screw
plug.
(b) Remove the filter and gasket.
3.
REMOVE VALVE LIFTER
HINT:
Keep the valve lifters in the correct order so that they can
be returned to their original locations when
reassembling.
A088717E02
A038128E02
A088718E01
EM
EM–58
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
4.
REMOVE INTAKE VALVE
(a) Using SST, compress the valve spring and remove
the 2 retainer locks, valve, retainer and valve spring.
SST 09202-70020 (09202-00010, 09202-01010,
09202-01020)
HINT:
Keep the valves, valve springs and spring retainers
in the correct order so that they can be returned to
their original locations when reassembling.
5.
REMOVE EXHAUST VALVE
(a) Using SST, compress the valve spring and remove
the 2 retainer locks, valve, retainer and valve spring.
SST 09202-70020 (09202-00010, 09202-01010,
09202-01020)
HINT:
Keep the valves, valve springs and spring retainers
in the correct order so that they can be returned to
their original locations when reassembling.
6.
REMOVE VALVE STEM OIL SEAL
(a) Using needle-nose pliers, remove the oil seal.
7.
REMOVE VALVE SPRING SEAT
(a) Using compressed air and a magnetic finger,
remove the valve spring seat.
HINT:
Keep the valve seats in the correct order so that
they can be returned to their original locations when
reassembling.
SST
A037109E02
EM
A080961E01
A080962E01
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
8.
EM–59
REMOVE STUD BOLT
(a) Using E5 and E7 "torx" sockets, remove the 7 stud
bolts.
Upper Side
Front Side
Exhaust Manifold Side
EM
Intake Manifold Side
A092363E02
9.
A088720E01
REMOVE CAMSHAFT BEARING CAP SETTING RING
PIN
(a) Remove the 2 ring pins indicated in the illustration.
EM–60
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
INSPECTION
1.
Cylinder Block Side
INSPECT CYLINDER HEAD FOR FLATNESS
(a) Using a precision straightedge and feeler gauge,
measure the warpage of the contact surfaces of the
cylinder head and cylinder block, and cylinder head
and manifolds.
Maximum warpage
Surface
Cylinder block side
Specified Condition
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
Intake manifold side
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
Exhaust manifold side
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
Intake Manifold Side
If the warpage is greater than the maximum, replace
the cylinder head.
EM
Exhaust Manifold Side
A050931E01
2.
INSPECT CYLINDER HEAD FOR CRACKS
(a) Using a dye penetrant, check the combustion
chamber, intake ports, exhaust ports and cylinder
block surface for cracks.
If cracked, replace the cylinder head.
3.
INSPECT CYLINDER HEAD SET BOLT
(a) Using a vernier caliper, measure the length of the
head bolts from the seat to the end.
Standard length:
142.8 to 144.2 mm (5.622 to 5.677 in.)
Maximum length:
147.1 mm (5.791 in.)
If the length is greater than the maximum, replace
the bolt.
A001071E01
Underhead Length
A098332E01
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
4.
EM–61
INSPECT CYLINDER BLOCK FOR FLATNESS
(a) Using a precision straightedge and feeler gauge,
measure the surface that is in contact with the
cylinder head gasket for warpage.
Maximum warpage:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
If the warpage is greater than the maximum, replace
the cylinder block.
EM
A037353E01
5.
INSPECT INTAKE VALVE
(a) Check the overall valve length.
Standard overall length:
89.25 mm (3.5138 in.)
Minimum overall length:
88.95 mm (3.5020 in.)
If the overall length is less than the minimum,
replace the valve.
EM02534E06
(b) Using a micrometer, measure the diameter of the
valve stem.
Standard valve stem diameter:
4.970 to 4.985 mm (0.1957 to 0.1963 in.)
Z000052E01
(c) Check the valve head margin thickness.
Standard margin thickness:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
Minimum margin thickness:
0.7 mm (0.028 in.)
If the margin thickness is less than the minimum,
replace the valve.
Margin Thickness
EM00181E03
EM–62
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
6.
INSPECT EXHAUST VALVE
(a) Check the overall valve length.
Standard overall length:
87.90 mm (3.4606 in.)
Minimum overall length:
87.60 mm (3.4488 in.)
If the overall length is less than the minimum,
replace the valve.
(b) Using a micrometer, measure the diameter of the
valve stem.
Standard valve stem diameter:
4.965 to 4.980 mm (0.1955 to 0.1961 in.)
(c) Check the valve head margin thickness.
Standard margin thickness:
1.15 mm (0.0453 in.)
Minimum margin thickness:
0.85 mm (0.0335 in.)
If the margin thickness is less than the minimum,
replace the valve.
7.
INSPECT VALVE SPRING
(a) Using a vernier caliper, measure the free length of
the valve spring.
Standard free length:
59.77 mm (2.3531 in.)
If the free length is not as specified, replace the
spring.
EM
EM00801E01
(b) Using a steel square, measure the deviation of the
valve spring.
Maximum deviation:
1.6 mm (0.063 in.)
Maximum angle (reference):
2°
If the deviation is greater than the maximum,
replace the spring.
EM00988E01
EM00281E01
(c) Using a spring tester, measure the tension of the
valve spring at the specified installed length.
Standard installed tension:
140 to 154 N (14.2 to 15.7 kgf, 31.5 to 34.6 lbf)
at 32.5 mm (1.280 in.)
Maximum working tension:
180 to 198 N (18.4 to 20.2 kgf, 40.5 to 44.5 lbf)
at 25.1 mm (0.988 in.)
If the installed tension is not as specified, replace
the valve spring.
EM–63
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
8.
INSPECT VALVE GUIDE BUSH OIL CLEARANCE
(a) Using a caliper gauge, measure the inside diameter
of the guide bush.
Bush inside diameter:
5.010 to 5.030 mm (0.1972 to 0.1980 in.)
(b) Subtract the valve stem diameter measurement
from the guide bush inside diameter measurement.
Standard oil clearance
Guide Bush
A001478E01
Specified Condition
Intake
0.025 to 0.060 mm (0.0010 to 0.0024
in.)
Exhaust
0.030 to 0.065 mm (0.0012 to 0.0026
in.)
Maximum oil clearance
Guide Bush
Specified Condition
Intake
0.08 mm (0.0032 in.)
Exhaust
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
If the clearance is greater than the maximum,
replace the valve and guide bush (see page EM69).
9.
Width
A050036E01
45°
20°
1.0 to 1.4 mm (0.039 to 0.055 in.)
A092365E01
INSPECT INTAKE AND EXHAUST VALVE SEAT
(a) Apply a light coat of Prussian blue to the valve face.
(b) Lightly press the valve against the seat.
(c) Check the valve face and seat according to the
following procedure.
(1) If blue appears 360° around the face, the valve
is concentric. If not, replace the valve.
(2) If blue appears 360° around the valve seat, the
guide and face are concentric. If not, resurface
the seat.
(3) Check that the seat contact is in the middle of
the valve face with the width between 1.0 to 1.4
mm (0.039 to 0.055 in.).
10. REPAIR INTAKE VALVE SEAT
(a) If the seating is too high on the valve face, use 20°
and 45° cutters to correct the seat.
EM
EM–64
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
75°
45°
(b) If the seating is too low on the valve face, use 75°
and 45° cutters to correct the seat.
(c) Hand-lap the valve and valve seat with an abrasive
compound.
(d) Recheck the valve seating position.
1.0 to 1.4 mm (0.039 to 0.055 in.)
A092366E01
45°
11. REPAIR EXHAUST VALVE SEAT
(a) If the seating is too high on the valve face, use 20°
and 45° cutters to correct the seat.
20°
EM
1.0 to 1.4 mm (0.039 to 0.055 in.)
A092365E01
75°
45°
(b) If the seating is too low on the valve face, use 75°
and 45° cutters to correct the seat.
(c) Hand-lap the valve and valve seat with an abrasive
compound.
(d) Recheck the valve seating position.
1.0 to 1.4 mm (0.039 to 0.055 in.)
A092366E01
12. INSPECT VALVE LIFTER
(a) Using a micrometer, measure the lifter diameter.
Standard lifter diameter:
30.966 to 30.976 mm (1.2191 to 1.2195 in.)
P016860E01
A088724E01
13. INSPECT VALVE LIFTER OIL CLEARANCE
(a) Using a caliper gauge, measure the lifter bore
diameter of the cylinder head.
Standard lifter bore diameter:
31.009 to 31.025 mm (1.2208 to 1.2215 in.)
(b) Subtract the lifter diameter measurement from the
lifter bore diameter measurement.
Standard oil clearance:
0.033 to 0.059 mm (0.0013 to 0.0023 in.)
Maximum oil clearance:
0.1 mm (0.0039 in.)
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
EM–65
If the oil clearance is greater than the maximum,
replace the lifter. If necessary, replace the cylinder
head.
14. INSPECT CAMSHAFT TIMING GEAR OPERATION
(a) Check the lock of the camshaft timing gear.
(1) Clamp the camshaft in a vise, and check that
the camshaft timing gear is locked.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the camshaft.
Retard Side
Paths
Advance
Side Paths
Close
Open
Vinyl Tape
Open
(b) Release the lock pin.
(1) Cover the 4 oil paths of the cam journal with
tape as shown in the illustration.
HINT:
One of the 2 grooves located on the cam
journal is for retarding cam timing (upper) and
the other is for advancing cam timing (lower).
Each groove has 2 oil paths. Plug one of the oil
paths for each groove with rubber pieces
before wrapping the cam journal with the tape.
(2) Puncture the tape for the advance oil path and
for the retard oil path on the opposite side from
the advance oil path.
Close
Rubber Piece
A051761E02
Retard
Side Path
Advance
Side Path
(3) Apply about 150 kPa (1.5 kgf/cm2, 22 psi) of air
pressure into the 2 broken tape paths (the
advance side path and retard side path).
NOTICE:
Cover the paths with cloth or equivalent to
prevent oil from splashing.
A051762E01
Retard
Side Path
Decompress
Advanced
Side Path
Hold Pressure
A051763E01
(4) Confirm that the camshaft timing gear
assembly revolves in the timing advance
direction when reducing the air pressure of the
timing retard path.
HINT:
The lock pin is released, and the camshaft
timing gear revolves in the advance direction.
EM
EM–66
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
(5) When the camshaft timing gear reaches the
most advanced position, release the air
pressure from the timing retard side path, and
then release the air pressure from the timing
advance side path.
NOTICE:
The camshaft timing gear assembly
occasionally shifts to the retard side
abruptly if the air compression of the
advanced side path is released first. This
often results in the breakage of the lock pin.
(c) Check the smooth movable range.
(1) Rotate the camshaft timing gear within its
movable range several times, but do not turn it
to the most retarded position. Check that the
gear rotates smoothly.
Standard condition:
Smooth movable range is about 22.5°
NOTICE:
Be sure to perform this check by hand. Do
not use air pressure.
(d) Check the lock in the most retarded position.
(1) Confirm that the camshaft timing gear
assembly is locked at the most retarded
position.
EM
A037071E01
A037072E01
15. INSPECT CAMSHAFT TIMING GEAR
(a) Wrap the chain around the timing sprocket.
(b) Using a vernier caliper, measure the diameter of the
timing gear with the chain.
Minimum gear diameter (w/ chain):
96.2 mm (3.787 in.)
If the diameter is less than the minimum, replace the
sprocket.
NOTICE:
The vernier caliper must come into contact with
the chain link when measuring.
16. INSPECT CAMSHAFT TIMING SPROCKET
(a) Wrap the chain around the timing sprocket.
(b) Using a vernier caliper, measure the diameter of the
timing gear with the chain.
Minimum gear diameter (w/ chain):
96.2 mm (3.787 in.)
If the diameter is less than the minimum, replace the
sprocket.
NOTICE:
The vernier caliper must come into contact with
the chain link when measuring.
EM–67
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
17. INSPECT CAMSHAFT
(a) Inspect the camshaft for runout.
(1) Place the camshaft on V-blocks.
(2) Using a dial indicator, measure the circle runout
at the center journal.
Maximum circle runout:
0.03 mm (0.0012 in.)
If the circle runout is greater than the
maximum, replace the camshaft.
A088725E01
(b) Inspect the cam lobes.
(1) Using a micrometer, measure the cam lobe
height.
Standard cam lobe height:
42.310 to 42.410 mm (1.6657 to 1.6697 in.)
Minimum cam lobe height:
42.16 mm (1.6598 in.)
If the cam lobe height is less than the minimum,
replace the camshaft.
A037113E01
(c) Inspect the camshaft journals.
(1) Using a micrometer, measure the journal
diameter.
Standard journal diameter
Journal
A037114E01
Specified Condition
No. 1 journal
34.449 to 34.465 mm (1.3563 to
1.3569 in.)
Other journals
22.949 to 22.965 mm (0.9035 to
0.9041 in.)
If the journal diameter is not as specified, check
the oil clearance.
18. INSPECT NO. 2 CAMSHAFT
(a) Inspect the camshaft for runout.
(1) Place the camshaft on V-blocks.
(2) Using a dial indicator, measure the circle runout
at the center journal.
Maximum circle runout:
0.03 mm (0.0012 in.)
If the circle runout is greater than the
maximum, replace the camshaft.
(b) Inspect the cam lobes.
(1) Using a micrometer, measure the cam lobe
height.
Standard cam lobe height:
44.046 to 44.146 (1.7341 to 1.7380 in.)
Minimum cam lobe height:
43.90 mm (1.7283 in.)
If the cam lobe height is less than the minimum,
replace the camshaft.
EM
EM–68
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
(c) Inspect the camshaft journals.
(1) Using a micrometer, measure the journal
diameter.
Standard journal diameter
Journal
Specified Condition
No. 1 journal
34.449 to 34.465 mm (1.3563 to
1.3569 in.)
Other journals
22.949 to 22.965 mm (0.9035 to
0.9041 in.)
If the journal diameter is not as specified, check
the oil clearance.
19. INSPECT CAMSHAFT THRUST CLEARANCE
(a) Install the camshafts.
EM
(b) Using a dial indicator, measure the thrust clearance
while moving the camshaft back and forth.
Standard thrust clearance:
0.040 to 0.095 mm (0.0016 to 0.0037 in.)
Maximum thrust clearance:
0.11 mm (0.0043 in.)
If the thrust clearance is greater than the maximum,
replace the camshaft. If necessary, replace the
bearing caps and the cylinder head.
A001455E01
20. INSPECT CAMSHAFT OIL CLEARANCE
(a) Clean the bearing caps and the camshaft journals.
(b) Place the camshafts on the cylinder head.
(c) Lay a strip of Plastigage across each of the
camshaft journals.
(d) Install the bearing caps.
Torque: 23 N*m (235 kgf*cm, 17 ft.*lbf) for No. 1
13 N*m (129 kgf*cm, 9 ft.*lbf) for No. 2
NOTICE:
Do not turn the camshaft.
(e) Remove the bearing caps.
Plastigage
A001452E01
(f)
A001453E01
Measure the Plastigage at its widest point.
Standard oil clearance:
0.040 to 0.095 mm (0.0016 to 0.0037 in.)
Maximum oil clearance:
0.115 mm (0.0045 in.)
If the oil clearance is greater than the maximum,
replace the camshaft. If necessary, replace the
bearing caps and the cylinder head.
NOTICE:
Completely remove the Plastigage.
EM–69
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
REPLACEMENT
1.
REPLACE INTAKE VALVE GUIDE BUSH
(a) Heat the cylinder head to 80 to 100°C (176 to
212°F).
A001067E01
(b) Using SST and a hammer, tap out the guide bush.
SST 09201-10000 (09201-01050), 09950-70010
(09951-07100)
SST
EM
A037110E01
(c) Using a caliper gauge, measure the bush bore
diameter of the cylinder head.
Standard bore diameter
Bush size
A001445E01
Specified Condition
STD
9.685 to 9.706 mm (0.3813 to 0.3821
in.)
O/S 0.05
9.735 to 9.756 mm (0.3833 to 0.3841
in.)
If the bush bore diameter of the cylinder head is
greater than 9.706 mm (0.3821 in.), machine the
bush bore to a dimension of 9.735 to 9.755 mm
(0.3833 to 0.3841 in.).
If the bush bore diameter of the cylinder head is
greater than 9.756 mm (0.3841 in.), replace the
cylinder head.
(d) Heat the cylinder head to 80 to 100°C (176 to
212°F).
(e) Using SST and a hammer, tap in a new guide bush
to the specified protrusion height.
SST 09201-10000 (09201-01050), 09950-70010
(09951-07100)
Standard protrusion height:
9.0 to 9.4 mm (0.354 to 0.370 in.)
SST
9.0 to 9.4 mm
A080977E02
EM–70
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
(f)
2.
A001447E01
Using a sharp 5 mm reamer, ream the guide bush to
obtain the standard specified clearance between the
guide bush and the valve stem.
Standard oil clearance:
0.025 to 0.060 mm (0.0010 to 0.0024 in.)
REPLACE EXHAUST VALVE GUIDE BUSH
(a) Heat the cylinder head to 80 to 100°C (176 to
212°F).
(b) Using SST and a hammer, tap out the guide bush.
SST 09201-10000 (09201-01050), 09950-70010
(09951-07100)
(c) Using a caliper gauge, measure the bush bore
diameter of the cylinder head.
Standard bore diameter
EM
Bush size
Specified Condition
STD
9.685 to 9.706 mm (0.3813 to 0.3821
in.)
O/S 0.05
9.735 to 9.756 mm (0.3833 to 0.3841
in.)
If the bush bore diameter of the cylinder head is
greater than 9.706 mm (0.3821 in.), machine the
bush bore to a dimension of 9.735 to 9.755 mm
(0.3833 to 0.3841 in.).
If the bush bore diameter of the cylinder head is
greater than 9.756 mm (0.3841 in.), replace the
cylinder head.
(d) Heat the cylinder head to 80 to 100°C (176 to
212°F).
(e) Using SST and a hammer, tap in a new guide bush
to the specified protrusion height.
SST 09201-10000 (09201-01050), 09950-70010
(09951-07100)
Standard protrusion height:
9.0 to 9.4 mm (0.354 to 0.370 in.)
(f) Using a sharp 5 mm reamer, ream the guide bush to
obtain the standard specified clearance between the
guide bush and valve stem.
Standard oil clearance:
0.030 to 0.065 mm (0.0012 to 0.0026 in.)
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
EM–71
REASSEMBLY
8.5 to 9.5 mm
A080980E03
1.
INSTALL CAMSHAFT BEARING CAP SETTING RING
PIN
(a) Using a plastic-faced hammer, tap in a new ring pin
to the specified protrusion height.
Standard protrusion height:
8.5 to 9.5 mm (0.335 to 0.374 in.)
2.
INSTALL STUD BOLT
(a) Using E5 and E7 "torx" sockets, install the 7 stud
bolts.
Torque: 10 N*m (102 kgf*cm, 7.4 ft.*lbf) for bolt
A
4.0 N*m (41 kgf*cm, 35 in.*lbf) for bolt B
10 N*m (102 kgf*cm, 7.4 ft.*lbf) for bolt
C
9.0 N*m (92 kgf*cm, 80 in.*lbf) for bolt D
EM
EM–72
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
A
C
EM
D
B
Stud Bolt
A
26.5 mm (1.043 in.)
43.5 mm
(1.713 in.)
19.5 mm (0.768 in.)
Stud Bolt
B
38.5 mm (1.516 in.)
12.0 mm (0.472 in.)
12.0 mm (0.472 in.)
28.5 mm (1.220 in.)
49.5 mm
(1.949 in.)
Stud Bolt
C
13.0 mm (0.512 in.)
Stud Bolt
D
22.5 mm (0.886 in.)
37.5 mm (1.476 in.)
13.0 mm (0.512 in.)
A117402E01
3.
Intake Side
Exhaust Side
Gray
Black
A092940E02
INSTALL VALVE STEM OIL SEAL
(a) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the valve stem.
NOTICE:
Installing the oil seals for the intake and exhaust
onto the opposite valve guide bush may cause
failures.
HINT:
The intake valve oil seal is gray and the exhaust
valve oil seal is black.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
EM–73
(b) Using SST, push in a new oil seal.
SST 09201-41020
SST
A001063E01
4.
INSTALL INTAKE VALVE
(a) Install the valve, spring seat, valve spring and spring
retainer.
NOTICE:
Install the same parts in the same combination
to their original locations.
A001065E01
(b) Using SST, compress the valve spring and place the
2 retainer locks around the valve stem.
SST 09202-70020 (09202-00010)
SST
A037109E01
(c) Using a plastic-faced hammer and valve stem (not
in use) with the tip wrapped in tape, lightly tap the
valve stem tip to ensure a proper fit.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the valve stem tip.
5.
A007307E01
INSTALL EXHAUST VALVE
(a) Install the valve, spring seat, valve spring, and
spring retainer.
(b) Using SST, compress the valve spring and place the
2 retainer locks around the valve stem.
SST 09202-70020 (09202-00010)
(c) Using a plastic-faced hammer and valve stem (not
in use) with the tip wrapped in tape, lightly tap the
valve stem tip to ensure a proper fit.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the valve stem tip.
EM
EM–74
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
Mesh
6.
INSTALL OIL CONTROL VALVE FILTER
(a) Using an 8 mm hexagon wrench, install the filter
with a new gasket and the screw plug.
Torque: 30 N*m (306 kgf*cm, 22 ft.*lbf)
7.
INSTALL VALVE LIFTER
(a) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the valve lifter.
(b) Install the valve lifter.
(c) Check that the valve lifter rotates smoothly by hand.
8.
INSTALL NO. 1 TAPER SCREW PLUG
(a) Using a 10 mm hexagon wrench, install the taper
screw plug with a new gasket.
Torque: 44 N*m (449 kgf*cm, 33 ft.*lbf)
A050664E01
EM
A088717E02
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
EM–75
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL FUEL INJECTOR (See page EM-155)
2.
INSTALL FUEL DELIVERY PIPE (See page EM-156)
3.
INSTALL ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE
SENSOR (See page ES-446)
4.
INSTALL NOISE FILTER (See page EM-102)
5.
INSTALL EXHAUST MANIFOLD (See page EM-102)
6.
INSTALL INTAKE MANIFOLD (See page EM-103)
7.
INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD GASKET
(a) Place a new head gasket on the cylinder block with
the Lot No. facing upward.
NOTICE:
• Remove any oil from the contact surface.
• Be careful of the installation direction.
• Do not damage the cylinder head gasket
when installing it.
Lot No.
8.
A092832E02
Cylinder Head
Diameter:
4.5 to 5.5 mm
Cylinder Head
Gasket
Cylinder Block
INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD
HINT:
The cylinder head bolts are tightened in 2 successive
steps.
(a) Apply seal packing as shown in the illustration.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing 1282B, Three
Bond 1282B or Equivalent
Standard seal diameter:
4.5 to 5.5 mm (0.177 to 0.217 in.)
NOTICE:
• Remove any oil from the contact surface.
• Install the cylinder head within 3 minutes of
applying seal packing.
(b) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads of the
cylinder head bolts.
Seal Packing
A073748E02
8
4
2
5
10
6
1
3
(c) Using several steps, install and tighten the 10
cylinder head bolts and plate washers uniformly with
an 8 mm bi-hexagon wrench in the sequence shown
in the illustration.
Torque: 29 N*m (296 kgf*cm, 21 ft.*lbf)
9
7
A035286E03
EM
EM–76
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
90°
(d) Mark the front of the cylinder head bolt with paint.
(e) Retighten the cylinder head bolts by an additional
90° and then another 90°, as shown in the
illustration.
(f) Check that the paint mark is now 180° opposite to
the front.
90°
Front
Paint Mark
EM
A092833E01
9.
40q
Timing Mark
INSTALL CAMSHAFT
NOTICE:
If turning the camshaft with the chain removed, turn
the crankshaft counterclockwise by 40° from TDC/
compression.
(a) Apply engine oil to the cam and cylinder head
journals.
A092826E01
(b) Place the camshaft and No. 2 camshaft on the
cylinder head with the timing mark on the camshaft
timing gear facing upward.
Timing Mark
A093712E01
(c) Check the front marks and numbers on the No. 1
and No. 2 camshaft bearing caps, then temporarily
install them.
A087642E01
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
5
3
1
2
4
No. 1 Camshaft Bearing Cap
EM–77
(d) Uniformly tighten the No. 2 camshaft bearing caps
in several steps in the sequence shown in the
illustration.
Torque: 13 N*m (130 kgf*cm, 9.6 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Uniformly loosen the bolts, keeping the
camshaft level.
(e) Install the No. 1 camshaft bearing cap.
Torque: 23 N*m (235 kgf*cm, 17 ft.*lbf)
A093713E01
10. INSTALL OIL DIPSTICK GUIDE
(a) Install the dipstick guide with the bolt.
Torque: 9.0 N*m (92 kgf*cm, 80 in.*lbf)
(b) Connect the hose.
11. INSTALL NO. 1 WATER BY-PASS PIPE
(a) Connect the water by-pass pipe with the bolt.
Torque: 9.0 N*m (92 kgf*cm, 80 in.*lbf)
A087640E01
12. CONNECT HOSES
(a) Connect the hoses shown in the illustration.
A087638E01
13. REMOVE RADIATOR INLET HOSE
(a) Connect the radiator inlet hose.
A087637E01
14. CONNECT FUEL MAIN TUBE
(a) Push the fuel tube into the fuel delivery pipe until it
makes a "click" sound.
HINT:
• If the fuel tube is connected too tightly, apply a
light coat of engine oil to the tip of the fuel
delivery pipe.
• After connecting, check that the fuel tube is
securely connected by pulling it.
A087643E01
EM
EM–78
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
(b) Install the fuel pipe clamp.
15. CONNECT WIRE HARNESS
(a) Connect the connectors and wire harnesses shown
in the illustration.
A087635E01
EM
A087634E01
16. INSTALL CHAIN
(a) Install the chain to the engine (see page EM-35).
17. INSTALL INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the inverter with converter to the vehicle (see
page HV-535).
18. INSTALL FRONT EXHAUST ASSEMBLY (See page
EX-3)
19. INSTALL SERVICE PLUG GRIP (See page HB-154)
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – CYLINDER HEAD
EM–79
20. CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL (See page CH-7)
21. CHECK FOR FUEL LEAKS (See page FU-8)
22. INSTALL REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
23. INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-8)
24. INSTALL REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
25. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
EM
EM–80
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
ENGINE ASSEMBLY
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
WINDSHIELD WIPER ARM COVER
FRONT WIPER ARM RH
FRONT WIPER ARM LH
21 (56, 16)
21 (56, 16)
x2
EM
HOOD TO COWL TOP SEAL
COWL TOP VENTILATOR
LOUVER LH
COWL TOP
VENTILATOR
LOUVER RH
x5
WIPER MOTOR CONNECTOR
8.4 (86, 74 in.*lbf)
WINDSHIELD WIPER
MOTOR AND LINK
ASSEMBLY
FRONT OUTER COWL TOP PANEL
6.4 (65, 57 in.*lbf)
NO. 2 ENGINE ROOM
RELAY BLOCK
x2
8.4 (86, 74 in.*lbf)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A124444E04
EM–81
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
x 12
11 (112, 8.1)
EM
INVERTER COVER
11 (112, 8.1)
NO. 2 INVERTER COOLING HOSE
INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
NO. 1 INVERTER
COOLING HOSE
ENGINE ROOM
MAIN WIRE
HARNESS
NO. 1 CIRCUIT BREAKER
SENSOR CONNECTOR
NO. 6 INVERTER COOLING HOSE
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A124481E01
EM–82
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
EM
21 (214, 16)
21 (214, 16)
21 (214, 16)
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
MG2 POWER CABLE
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
MG1 POWER CABLE
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A124446E02
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
EM–83
x6
RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
8.5 (87, 75 in.*lbf)
INVERTER BRACKET
21 (214, 16)
20 (204, 15)
COOLER BRACKET
x5
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
EM
25 (255, 18)
x2
RADIATOR
SUPPORT
HOOD LOCK
CONTROL CABLE
HOOD LOCK
HORN CONNECTOR
FRONT BUMPER COVER
ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
x3
x2
x2
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
x3
x4
ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
A124482E01
EM–84
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
NO. 1 INVERTER COOLING HOSE
RADIATOR OUTLET HOSE
RADIATOR INLET HOSE
NO. 2 INVERTER COOLING HOSE
WIRE HARNESS
FAN MOTOR CONNECTOR
EM
HOSE CLAMP
RADIATOR DRAIN COCK PLUG
HOSE CLAMP
NO. 1 HEAT STORAGE
WATER BY-PASS HOSE
TEMPERATURE SWITCH CONNECTOR
NO. 5 INVERTER COOLING HOSE
A124483E01
EM–85
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
x4
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
FAN WITH MOTOR ASSEMBLY
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
RADIATOR SUPPORT
UPPER RH
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
RADIATOR SUPPORT
UPPER LH
3.9 (40, 35 in.*lbf)
RADIATOR FAN
TEMPERATURE
SWITCH
3.9 (40, 35 in.*lbf)
NO. 2 RADIATOR
ASSEMBLY
RADIATOR SUPPORT
LOWER LH
RADIATOR SUPPORT
LOWER LH
3.9 (40, 35 in.*lbf)
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
3.9 (40, 35 in.*lbf)
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A124484E01
EM
EM–86
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
LOWER CENTER INSTRUMENT PANEL
FINISH PANEL
x2
POWER OUTLET CONNECTOR
EM
FRONT FLOOR CARPET
GASKET
COMPRESSION SPRING
43 (440, 32)
x2
GASKET
COMPRESSION SPRING
x2
FRONT EXHAUST PIPE
x4
43 (440, 32)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
FRONT FLOOR
PANEL BRACE
30 (302, 22)
Non-reusable part
A124485E01
EM–87
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
COLUMN HOLE COVER
SILENCER SHEET
NO. 1 AIR CLEANER INLET
PURGE VSV
FUEL PIPE CLAMP
7.5 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
FUEL TUBE
STEERING SLIDING YOKE
HEATER WATER HOSE
NO. 3 HEAT STORAGE
WATER BY-PASS HOSE
FRONT
STABILIZER
LINK LH
CLIP
49 (500, 36)
x3
25 (255, 18)
35 (357, 26)
COOLER COMPRESSOR
WITH MOTOR ASSEMBLY
89 (908, 66)
NO. 3 INVERTER
COOLING HOSE
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT LH
TIE ROD END LH
216 (2,203, 160)
FRONT AXLE
HUB NUT LH
NO. 1 HEAT STORAGE
WATER BY-PASS HOSE
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
NO. 1 FRONT SUSPENSION
ARM LOWER LH
Non-reusable part
A124486E01
EM
EM–88
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
52 (530, 38)
x2
80 (816, 59)
EM
x2
52 (530, 38)
100 (1,020, 74)
x2
x2
x2
x2
x2
56 (571, 41)
ENGINE MOVING CONTROL ROD WITH BRACKET
113 (1,152, 83)
157 (1,602, 116)
FRONT SUSPENSION CROSSMEMBER ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A124487E01
EM–89
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
7.0 (71, 62 in.*lbf)
EM
ENGINE HANGER
CLAMP
40 (408, 30)
ENGINE HANGER
FLYWHEEL
40 (408, 30)
49 (500, 36)
STARTER HOLE
INSULATOR
32 (326, 24)
x6
TRANSMISSION
INPUT DAMPER
x6
20 (204, 15)
FLYWHEEL HOUSING
SIDE COVER
HYBRID VEHICLE
TRANSAXLE
ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A124488E01
EM–90
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
NO. 1 WATER BY-PASS PIPE
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
x2
EM
GASKET
OIL DIPSTICK
OIL DIPSTICK
GUIDE
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
O-RING
KNOCK SENSOR
20 (204, 15)
ENGINE OIL PRESSURE
SWITCH
DRIVE BELT
40 (408, 30)
IDLER PULLEY
RADIATOR
OUTLET HOSE
20 (204, 15)
20 (204, 15)
x2
x3
GASKET
INTAKE MANIFOLD
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A124489E01
EM–91
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
NO. 1 EXHAUST MANIFOLD
INSULATOR
x4
EM
IGNITION COIL
x4
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
x4
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
NOISE FILTER
27 (275, 20)
GASKET
GASKET
20 (204, 15)
ENGINE COOLANT
TEMPERATURE SENSOR
EXHAUST MANIFOLD
27 (275, 20)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A124490E01
EM–92
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
REMOVAL
EM
1.
PRECAUTION
CAUTION:
The hybrid system uses high voltage circuits, so
improper handling could cause an electric shock or
leakage. During service (e.g. installing or removing
the parts, inspection, replacing the parts), be sure to
follow the procedures (see page HV-519).
2.
REMOVE NO. 2 REAR FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
3.
REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-4)
4.
REMOVE NO. 3 REAR FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
5.
DISCHARGE FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE (See page
FU-12)
6.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
7.
REMOVE SERVICE PLUG GRIP (See page HB-154)
8.
REMOVE FRONT WHEELS
9.
REMOVE NO. 3 ENGINE UNDER COVER
10. REMOVE NO. 4 CENTER ENGINE UNDER COVER
(See page ET-3)
11. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-6)
12. DRAIN TRANSAXLE OIL (See page HX-67)
13. REMOVE WIPER ARM HEAD CAP
14. REMOVE FRONT WIPER ARM LH (See page WW-13)
15. REMOVE FRONT WIPER ARM RH (See page WW-13)
16. REMOVE HOOD TO COWL TOP SEAL (See page
WW-13)
17. REMOVE COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER LH (See
page WW-13)
18. REMOVE COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER RH (See
page WW-13)
19. REMOVE WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR AND LINK
ASSEMBLY (See page WW-13)
20. REMOVE FRONT OUTER COWL TOP PANEL (See
page FU-12)
21. REMOVE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the inverter with converter from the vehicle
(see page HV-530).
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
EM–93
22. REMOVE NO. 2 RADIATOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the No. 2 radiator from the vehicle (see
page CO-33).
23. DISCONNECT NO. 3 INVERTER COOLING HOSE
A087644
24. DISCONNECT NO. 1 HEAT STORAGE WATER BYPASS HOSE
(a) Disconnect the hose shown in the illustration.
A087645E01
25. DISCONNECT ENGINE WIRE
(a) Remove the bolt, then disconnect the ground cable.
A087646E01
26. SEPARATE NO. 1 AIR CLEANER INLET
(a) Loosen the clamp, then disconnect the air cleaner
inlet No. 1 from the air cleaner case.
A088023E01
EM
EM–94
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
27. REMOVE PURGE VSV
(a) Disconnect the connector and hose.
(b) Remove the bolt, then remove the vacuum
switching valve assembly.
A088024E01
28. DISCONNECT FUEL TUBE
(a) Remove the fuel pipe clamp.
EM
A088025E01
(b) Disconnect the fuel tube from the fuel delivery pipe.
NOTICE:
Even if the fuel tube is stuck and cannot be
disconnected, do not use any tools. Push and
pull the part with the quick connector pinched to
disconnect the tube.
(c) Cover the disconnected fuel tube and fuel delivery
pipe with plastic bags in order to prevent foreign
objects from entering them.
A088026E01
29. DISCONNECT HEATER WATER HOSE
A088027E01
30. DISCONNECT NO. 3 HEAT STORAGE WATER BYPASS HOSE
A088028E01
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
EM–95
31. DISCONNECT ENGINE WIRE
(a) Disconnect the connector from the ECM, then pull
the engine wire harness to the engine compartment
side.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly pull the engine wire harness to
the engine compartment side.
(b) Disconnect the harness and harness clamp from the
engine room main relay block.
(c) Disconnect the ground cable.
EM
A088029E02
A088030E02
32. DISCONNECT HEATER COMPRESSOR WITH
MOTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the wire harness of the compressor
assembly from the harness clamp.
(b) Remove the 3 bolts, then disconnect the
compressor assembly.
HINT:
Disconnect the compressor assembly together with
the low-pressure and high-pressure hoses, then
secure it to the vehicle side with rope.
33. DISCONNECT STEERING SLIDING YOKE
(a) Install the seat belt as illustrated so that the steering
wheel does not turn.
HINT:
This prevents an open circuit of the spiral cable.
A088159E01
(b) Remove the 2 clips, then remove the column hole
cover silencer sheet.
A088031E01
EM–96
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
(c) Loosen the bolt on the column side (A) of the sliding
yoke.
(d) Remove the bolt on the gear side (B) of the sliding
yoke.
(e) Put paint marks on the sliding yoke and
intermediate shaft, and then disconnect the sliding
yoke.
A
B
34. REMOVE FRONT EXHAUST PIPE (See page EX-2)
Paint Mark
A093709E01
35. REMOVE FRONT AXLE HUB NUT LH (See page DS5)
36. REMOVE FRONT AXLE HUB NUT RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
EM
37. DISCONNECT FRONT STABILIZER LINK LH (See
page SP-28)
38. DISCONNECT TIE ROD END LH (See page DS-6)
39. DISCONNECT TIE ROD END RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
40. DISCONNECT NO. 1 FRONT SUSPENSION ARM
LOWER LH (See page DS-6)
41. DISCONNECT NO. 1 FRONT SUSPENSION ARM
LOWER RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
42. DISCONNECT FRONT AXLE HUB LH (See page DS-6)
43. DISCONNECT FRONT AXLE HUB RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
44. REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT LH (See page DS-7)
45. REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT RH (See page DS-7)
46. REMOVE FRONT SUSPENSION CROSSMEMBER
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and 2 nuts, then remove the
engine moving control rod with bracket.
A088033E01
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
EM–97
(b) Remove the 4 bolts, then remove the front
suspension crossmember with power steering gear
assembly.
A088034E01
47. REMOVE ENGINE AND TRANSAXLE
(a) Set the engine lifter as illustrated.
EM
A088035E01
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and 2 nuts, then disconnect the
engine mounting bracket RH and engine mounting
insulator RH.
(c) Remove the nut, then disconnect the engine
mounting insulator bracket LH and engine mounting
insulator LH.
(d) Operate the engine lifter, then remove the engine
assembly with transaxle from the vehicle.
A088036E01
48. REMOVE AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the intake air flow meter connector and
wire harness clamp.
(b) Loosen the clamp, then remove the 2 bolts and air
cleaner assembly.
A088037E01
EM–98
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
49. REMOVE HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE
ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the bolt and ground cable.
A088038E01
EM
A088039E01
(b) Install the engine hangers to the engine assembly
with 2 new bolts as shown in the illustration.
Torque: 40 N*m (408 kgf*cm, 30 in.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Be sure to use new bolts to install the engine
hangers.
HINT:
• Engine hanger 12281-21010
• Bolt 91642-81052
(c) Using a chain block and engine sling device, hold
the engine assembly with transaxle.
(d) Remove the engine wire harness from the engine
assembly with transaxle.
(e) Remove the 2 bolts, then remove the starter hole
insulator and flywheel housing side cover.
(f) Remove the hybrid vehicle transaxle assembly from
the engine assembly (see page HX-66).
A088040E01
50. REMOVE TRANSMISSION INPUT DAMPER
(a) Using SST, hold the crankshaft.
SST 09213-58013 (91111-50845), 09330-00021
(b) Remove the 6 bolts, then remove the input damper
and input damper cover.
SST
A089849E01
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
EM–99
51. REMOVE FLYWHEEL
(a) Using SST, hold the crankshaft.
SST 09213-58013 (91111-50845), 09330-00021
(b) Remove the 6 bolts and flywheel.
SST
A092534E01
52. REMOVE OIL DIPSTICK GUIDE
(a) Remove the dipstick.
(b) Remove the bolt and dipstick guide.
EM
A088041E01
53. REMOVE INTAKE MANIFOLD
(a) Remove the bolt and knock control sensor with
bracket.
(b) Disconnect the wiring harness from the bracket.
(c) Disconnect the ventilation hose.
(d) Disconnect the water by-pass hose.
A088042E01
(e) Remove the 3 bolts and 2 nuts, then remove the
intake manifold and gasket.
A088043E01
EM–100
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
54. REMOVE NO. 1 WATER BY-PASS PIPE
(a) Remove the bolt, then disconnect the wire harness.
(b) Remove the 2 nuts and bolt, then remove the water
by-pass pipe No. 1 and gasket.
55. REMOVE KNOCK SENSOR (See page ES-459)
56. REMOVE ENGINE OIL PRESSURE SWITCH (See
page LU-1)
57. REMOVE DRIVE BELT (See page EM-6)
A088045E01
58. REMOVE IDLER PULLEY
(a) Remove the nut, then remove the idle pulley
assembly from the engine mounting bracket RH.
EM
A092817E01
59. REMOVE IGNITION COIL
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and 4 ignition coils.
A088163E01
60. REMOVE EXHAUST MANIFOLD
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and exhaust manifold insulator.
A088048E01
(b) Remove the 3 bolts and 2 nuts, then remove the
exhaust manifold.
A088051E02
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
EM–101
61. REMOVE NOISE FILTER
(a) Remove the bolt and noise filter.
A088050E01
62. REMOVE ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE
SENSOR
(a) Using a 19 mm deep socket wrench, remove the
engine coolant temperature sensor.
A089055E02
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT INTAKE MANIFOLD
(a) Using a precision straightedge and feeler gauge,
measure the surface contacting the cylinder head
for warpage.
Maximum warpage:
0.10 mm (0.004 in.)
Using a precision straightedge and feeler gauge,
measure the surface contacting the cylinder head
for warpage.
2.
INSPECT EXHAUST MANIFOLD
(a) Using a precision straightedge and feeler gauge,
measure the surface contacting the cylinder head
for warpage.
Maximum warpage:
0.70 mm (0.028 in.)
If the warpage is greater than the maximum, replace
the manifold.
A130329
A130330
INSTALLATION
1.
A089055E02
INSTALL ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE
SENSOR
(a) Install a new gasket, then install the engine coolant
temperature sensor.
Torque: 20 N*m (204 kgf*cm, 15 in.*lbf)
EM
EM–102
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
2.
INSTALL NOISE FILTER
(a) Install the noise filter with the bolt.
Torque: 9.0 N*m (92 kgf*cm, 80 in.*lbf)
3.
INSTALL EXHAUST MANIFOLD
(a) Install a new gasket, then install the exhaust
manifold.
(b) Tighten the 3 bolts and 2 nuts in the sequence
shown in the illustration.
Torque: 27 N*m (275 kgf*cm, 20 in.*lbf)
A088050E01
EM
1
4
5
2
3
A088052E02
(c) Install the exhaust manifold insulator with the 4
bolts.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
A088048E01
4.
INSTALL IGNITION COIL
(a) Install the ignition coil with the bolt.
Torque: 9.0 N*m (92 kgf*cm, 80 in.*lbf)
5.
INSTALL IDLER PULLEY
(a) Temporarily install the idler pulley assembly to the
engine mounting bracket RH with the nut.
HINT:
Tighten the nut to the specified torque when
installing the drive belt.
6.
INSTALL DRIVE BELT (See page EM-6)
7.
INSTALL ENGINE OIL PRESSURE SWITCH (See page
LU-1)
A088163E01
A092817E01
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
EM–103
8.
INSTALL KNOCK SENSOR (See page ES-460)
9.
INSTALL NO. 1 WATER BY-PASS PIPE
(a) Install a new gasket, then install the water by-pass
pipe with the bolt and 2 nuts.
Torque: 9.0 N*m (92 kgf*cm, 80 in.*lbf)
A088045E01
10. INSTALL INTAKE MANIFOLD
(a) Install a new gasket, then install the intake manifold
with the 3 bolts and 2 nuts.
A088043E01
(b) Connect the water by-pass hose.
(c) Connect the ventilation hose.
(d) Install the knock control sensor with bracket with the
bolt.
Torque: 9.0 N*m (92 kgf*cm, 80 in.*lbf)
A088042E01
11. INSTALL OIL DIPSTICK GUIDE
(a) Apply engine oil to a new O-ring, then install it to the
dipstick guide.
(b) Install the dipstick guide with the bolt.
Torque: 9.0 N*m (92 kgf*cm, 80 in.*lbf)
(c) Install the dipstick.
A088041E01
EM
EM–104
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
12. INSTALL FLYWHEEL
(a) Apply adhesive to 2 or 3 threads of the bolt end.
Adhesive:
Toyota Genuine Adhesive 1324, Three Bond
1324 or Equivalent
NOTICE:
Remove any oil from the bolts and bolt holes.
Adhesive
A004869E02
(b) Using SST, hold the crankshaft.
SST 09213-58013 (91111-50845), 09330-00021
(c) Install the flywheel with 6 new bolts.
Torque: 49 N*m (500 kgf*cm, 36 in.*lbf)
(d) After tightening the new bolts to the specified
torque, tighten each bolt by an additional 90°.
NOTICE:
Do not start the engine within 1 hour of
installation.
EM
SST
A092534E01
13. INSTALL TRANSMISSION INPUT DAMPER
(a) Using SST, align the hole of the input damper. Then
temporarily tighten the input damper cover with the
6 bolts.
SST 09301-00210
SST
A089851E01
(b) Using SST, hold the crankshaft.
SST 09213-58013 (91111-50845), 09330-00021
(c) Tighten the 6 bolts.
Torque: 20 N*m (204 kgf*cm, 15 in.*lbf)
14. INSTALL HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the hybrid vehicle transaxle assembly to the
engine assembly with the 6 bolts (see page HX-70).
SST
A089849E01
(b) Install the flywheel housing side cover and starter
hole insulator with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 32 N*m (326 kgf*cm, 24 in.*lbf)
(c) Install the engine wire harness to the engine
assembly with transaxle.
A088040E01
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
EM–105
(d) Remove the bolts and engine hangers.
A088039E01
(e) Install the ground cable with the bolt.
Torque: 9.0 N*m (92 kgf*cm, 80 in.*lbf)
EM
A088038E01
15. INSTALL AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the air cleaner with the 2 bolts and tighten the
clamp.
Torque: 7.0 N*m (71 kgf*cm, 62 in.*lbf) for bolt
3.0 N*m (31 kgf*cm, 27 in.*lbf) for clamp
A088037E01
16. INSTALL ENGINE AND TRANSAXLE
(a) Set the engine lifter as illustrated.
(b) Operate the engine lifter, then install the engine
assembly with transaxle to the vehicle.
A088035E01
EM–106
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
(c) Connect the engine mounting bracket RH and
engine mounting insulator RH with the 2 bolts and 2
nuts.
Torque: 52 N*m (530 kgf*cm, 38 in.*lbf)
(d) Connect the engine mounting insulator bracket LH
and engine mounting insulator LH with the nut.
Torque: 80 N*m (816 kgf*cm, 59 in.*lbf)
EM
A088036E01
A
A
B
17. INSTALL FRONT SUSPENSION CROSSMEMBER
(a) Install the front suspension crossmember with
power steering gear assembly with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 113 N*m (1,152 kgf*cm, 83 in.*lbf) for
bolt A
157 N*m (1,602 kgf*cm, 116 in.*lbf) for
bolt B
B
A089852E01
A
(b) Install the engine moving control rod with bracket
with the 4 bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque: 100 N*m (1020 kgf*cm, 74 in.*lbf) for
bolt A
56 N*m (571 kgf*cm, 41 in.*lbf) for bolt B
A
18. INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT LH (See page DS-15)
19. INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT RH (See page DS-15)
B
B
20. INSTALL FRONT AXLE HUB LH (See page DS-15)
A089853E01
21. INSTALL FRONT AXLE HUB RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
22. INSTALL NO. 1 FRONT SUSPENSION ARM LOWER
LH (See page SP-20)
23. INSTALL NO. 1 FRONT SUSPENSION ARM LOWER
RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
24. CONNECT TIE ROD END LH (See page DS-16)
25. CONNECT TIE ROD END RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
26. CONNECT FRONT STABILIZER LINK LH (See page
SP-29)
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
EM–107
27. INSTALL FRONT AXLE HUB NUT LH (See page DS16)
28. INSTALL FRONT AXLE HUB NUT RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
29. CONNECT STEERING SLIDING YOKE
(a) Align the paint marks, then connect the steering
sliding yoke with the bolt.
Torque: 35 N*m (357 kgf*cm, 26 in.*lbf)
(b) Install the column hole cover silencer sheet with the
2 clips.
(c) Remove the seat belt from the steering wheel.
A
B
Paint Mark
EM
A093709E01
30. CONNECT COOLER COMPRESSOR WITH MOTOR
ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the cooler compressor with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 25 N*m (255 kgf*cm, 18 in.*lbf)
A088030E02
31. CONNECT ENGINE WIRE
(a) Connect the ground cable.
(b) Connect the harness and clamp to the engine room
main relay block.
(c) Push in the engine wire harness, and then connect
the wire harness to the ECM.
A088029E02
32. CONNECT NO. 3 HEAT STORAGE WATER BY-PASS
HOSE
(a) Connect the No. 3 heat storage water by-pass hose.
A088028E01
EM–108
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
33. CONNECT HEATER WATER HOSE
A088027E01
34. CONNECT FUEL TUBE
(a) Push the fuel tube into the fuel delivery pipe until it
makes a "click" sound.
HINT:
• If the fuel tube is connected too tightly, apply a
light coat of engine oil to the tip of the fuel
delivery pipe.
• After connecting, check that the fuel tube is
securely connected by pulling it.
EM
A087643E01
(b) Install the fuel pipe clamp.
A087635E01
35. INSTALL PURGE VSV
(a) Install the purge VSV with the bolt.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (76 kgf*cm, 5.5 in.*lbf)
(b) Connect the hose and connector.
A088024E01
36. CONNECT NO. 1 AIR CLEANER INLET
(a) Connect the No. 1 air cleaner inlet to the air cleaner
case, and then tighten the clamp.
Torque: 3.0 N*m (31 kgf*cm, 27 in.*lbf)
A088023E01
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
EM–109
37. CONNECT ENGINE WIRE
(a) Connect the ground cable with the bolt.
A087646E01
38. CONNECT NO. 1 HEAT STORAGE WATER BY-PASS
HOSE
(a) Connect the hose as shown in the illustration.
EM
A087645E01
39. CONNECT NO. 3 INVERTER COOLING HOSE
40. INSTALL NO. 2 RADIATOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the radiator to the vehicle (see page CO-34).
41. INSTALL INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the inverter with converter to the vehicle (see
page HV-535).
A087644E01
42. INSTALL FRONT COWL TOP PANEL OUTER (See
page FU-19)
43. INSTALL WINDSHIELD WIPER LINK AND WIPER
MOTOR ASSEMBLY (See page WW-16)
44. INSTALL COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER RH
45. INSTALL COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER LH
46. INSTALL HOOD TO COWL TOP SEAL
47. INSTALL FRONT WIPER ARM LH (See page WW-16)
48. INSTALL FRONT WIPER ARM RH (See page WW-16)
49. INSTALL WIPER ARM HEAD CAP
50. ADD TRANSAXLE OIL (See page HX-74)
51. INSTALL SERVICE PLUG GRIP (See page HB-154)
52. CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL (See page CH-7)
53. INSTALL NO. 3 REAR FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
54. INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-8)
EM–110
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE ASSEMBLY
55. INSTALL NO. 2 REAR FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
56. ADD ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-7)
57. CHECK FOR TRANSAXLE FLUID LEVEL (See page
HX-74)
58. CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS (See page
CO-2)
59. CHECK FOR FUEL LEAKAGE (See page CO-2)
60. CHECK FOR ENGINE OIL LEAKS
61. INSTALL FRONT WHEELS
Torque: 103 N*m (1,050 kgf*cm, 76 in.*lbf)
EM
62. ADJUST FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
(a) Adjust the front wheel alignment (see page SP-2).
63. INSTALL NO. 3 ENGINE UNDER COVER
64. INSTALL NO. 4 CENTER ENGINE UNDER COVER
65. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
EM–111
ENGINE UNIT
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
10 (102, 7)
x2
OIL FILLER CAP
OIL FILLER CAP GASKET
VENTILATION VALVE
x7
x2
EM
10 (102, 7)
CYLINDER HEAD COVER
CYLINDER HEAD COVER
GASKET
18 (184, 13)
SPARK PLUG
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A116718E02
EM–112
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
55 (561, 41)
32 (326, 24)
ENGINE MOUNTING
BRACKET RH
24 (245, 18)
x4
24 (245, 18)
CRANKSHAFT
POSITION
SENSOR
TIMING CHAIN COVER
x2
EM
11 (112, 8)
x 11
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
x2
128 (1,305, 95)
CRANKSHAFT PULLEY
11 (112, 8)
STRAIGHT PIN
OIL PUMP SEAL
x3
GASKET
x2
WATER PUMP
15 (153, 11)
11 (112, 8)
WATER PUMP PULLEY
CHAIN TENSIONER
SLIPPER
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
CHAIN
x2
NO. 1 CHAIN
TENSIONER
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
O-RING
Non-reusable part
Apply MP grease
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
NO. 1 CHAIN VIBRATION DAMPER
A124491E03
EM–113
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
23 (235, 17)
NO. 1 CAMSHAFT
BEARING CAP
x3
x 16
x8
13 (129, 9)
NO. 2 CAMSHAFT
BEARING CAP
CAMSHAFT TIMING SPROCKET
EM
CAMSHAFT
64 (653, 47)
NO. 2 CAMSHAFT
CAMSHAFT TIMING GEAR
64 (653, 47)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A116719E01
EM–114
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
1st: 29 (300, 22)
2nd: Turn 90°
3rd: Turn 90°
FUEL DELIVERY PIPE
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
CYLINDER HEAD
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
19 (194, 14)
O-RING
FUEL INJECTOR
x4
SPACER
O-RING
EM
CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY
O-RING
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
CYLINDER HEAD GASKET
THERMOSTAT
ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
GASKET
O-RING
WATER INLET
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
x2
OIL PAN
OIL STRAINER
30 (306, 22)
OIL FILTER UNION
GASKET
17.5 (178, 13)
11 (112, 8)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
Apply MP grease
11 (112, 8)
OIL FILTER
x 13
x2
24 (245, 18)
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
NO. 2 OIL PAN
37.5 (382, 28)
GASKET
x9
x2
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
A116720E01
EM–115
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
NO. 1 COMPRESSION RING
NO. 2 COMPRESSION RING
OIL RING
(EXPANDER)
CONNECTING ROD
OIL RING
(SIDE RAIL)
PISTON
CONNECTING ROD BEARING
PISTON PIN
EM
CONNECTING ROD CAP
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
1st: 15 (153, 11)
2nd: 90°
STRAIGHT PIN
35 (357, 26)
STRAIGHT PIN
CYLINDER BLOCK
WATER DRAIN COCK
TIGHT PLUG
STRAIGHT PIN
STRAIGHT PIN
STRAIGHT PIN
11 (112, 8)
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
OIL JET (MASS
PRODUCTION PART)
OIL JET (SERVICE PART)
UPPER MAIN
BEARING
STRAIGHT PIN
STRAIGHT PIN
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
CRANKSHAFT THRUST WASHER
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
Precoated part
CRANKSHAFT
CRANKSHAFT
BEARING CAP
LOWER MAIN
BEARING
1st: 22 (224, 16)
2nd: 90°
A124506E01
EM–116
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE SPARK PLUG
(a) Using a 16 mm plug wrench, remove the 4 spark
plugs.
2.
REMOVE OIL FILLER CAP
(a) Remove the oil filler cap from the cylinder head
cover.
3.
REMOVE OIL FILLER CAP GASKET
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the gasket from the oil
filler cap.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
4.
REMOVE CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Remove the bolt and sensor.
5.
REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE
ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the bolt and oil control valve.
6.
REMOVE OIL FILTER
(a) Using SST, remove the oil filter.
SST 09228-06501
EM
A065656E01
A088868E02
A088869E02
SST
A088870E01
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
7.
EM–117
REMOVE THERMOSTAT
(a) Remove the 2 nuts and water inlet.
A088871E01
(b) Remove the thermostat.
(c) Remove the gasket from the thermostat.
EM
A088872E01
8.
REMOVE CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Remove the bolt and sensor.
9.
REMOVE WATER PUMP PULLEY
(a) Using SST, hold the pump pulley and remove the 3
bolts and pump pulley.
SST 09960-10010 (09962-01000, 09963-00600)
A088874E02
SST
A088875E02
10. REMOVE WATER PUMP
(a) Remove the 3 bolts and 2 nuts.
(b) Remove the water pump and gasket.
A088890E01
EM–118
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
11. REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET RH
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and engine mounting bracket
RH.
A088876E01
12. REMOVE VENTILATION VALVE
(a) Remove the ventilation valve from the cylinder head
cover.
EM
A080963E03
13. REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVER
(a) Remove the 9 bolts, 2 nuts and cylinder head cover.
(b) Remove the gasket from the cylinder head cover.
A066472E01
14. REMOVE CRANKSHAFT PULLEY
(a) Set the No. 1 cylinder to TDC/compression.
(1) Turn the crankshaft pulley until its timing notch
and timing mark 0 of the chain cover are
aligned.
(2) Check that both timing marks on the camshaft
timing sprocket and the camshaft timing gear
are facing upward as shown in the illustration.
If not, turn the crankshaft 1 complete revolution
(360°) and align the marks as above.
Timing Mark
A092837E01
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
EM–119
(b) Using SST, hold the crankshaft pulley and loosen
the crankshaft pulley set bolt.
SST 09213-58012 (91111-50845), 09330-00021
NOTICE:
When installing SST, be careful that the bolt
which holds SST does not interfere with the
chain cover.
SST
SST
A088877E01
(c) Loosen the crankshaft pulley set bolts until 2 to 3
threads of the bolt is tightened to the crankshaft.
(d) Using SST, remove the crankshaft pulley and
crankshaft pulley set bolt.
SST 09950-50013 (09951-05010, 09952-05010,
09953-05020, 09954-05021)
SST
A088878E01
(e) Remove the crankshaft straight pin.
A088879E01
15. REMOVE TIMING CHAIN COVER
(a) Remove the 15 bolts and nut.
A066477E01
EM
EM–120
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
(b) Using a screwdriver with the tip wrapped in tape,
remove the chain cover by prying between the
cylinder head and cylinder block.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the contact surfaces of
the chain cover, the cylinder head and the
cylinder block.
EM
A088880E01
(c) Remove the 2 O-rings from the cylinder block and
No. 1 oil pan.
A088881E01
(d) Using an 8 mm hexagon wrench, remove the screw
plug from the oil pump.
16. REMOVE OIL PUMP SEAL (See page EM-138)
A088882E01
17. REMOVE NO. 1 CHAIN TENSIONER
NOTICE:
• When rotating the camshaft with the timing chain
removed, rotate the crankshaft counterclockwise
40° from TDC and align the oil jet hole with the
paint mark to prevent the pistons from coming
into contact with the valves.
• Do not rotate the crankshaft with the chain
tensioner removed.
Oil Jet
Timing Mark
A050142E05
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
EM–121
(a) Lift up the stopper plate, then unlock the plunger.
(b) Push in the plunger to the end with the plunger
unlocked.
Plunger
Unlock
Stopper Plate
A092824E01
(c) Lower the stopper plate with the plunger pushed to
the end, then lock the plunger.
Plunger
EM
Stopper Plate
Lock
A092825E01
(d) Insert a 3.0 mm (0.118 in.) diameter bar into the
hole of the stopper plate with the plunger locked.
Plunger
Stopper Plate
A080976E02
HINT:
If the stopper plate is not completely lowered and a
3.0 mm (0.118 in.) diameter bar cannot be inserted,
unlock and pull out the plunger slightly. Then the
stopper plate will be completely lowered and a 3.0
mm (0.118 in.) diameter bar can be inserted easily.
A087621E01
(e) Remove the 2 bolts and chain tensioner.
A089044E01
EM–122
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
18. REMOVE CHAIN TENSIONER SLIPPER
(a) Remove the bolt and chain tensioner slipper.
A088883E02
19. REMOVE NO. 1 CHAIN VIBRATION DAMPER
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and chain vibration damper.
EM
A088884E01
20. REMOVE CHAIN
(a) Remove the chain from the engine.
A088885E01
21. REMOVE FUEL DELIVERY PIPE
(a) Remove the 3 bolts and fuel delivery pipe together
with the 4 fuel injectors.
A088886E01
(b) Remove the delivery pipe spacer from the cylinder
head.
A088887E01
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
EM–123
22. REMOVE FUEL INJECTOR
(a) Pull out the 4 injectors from the delivery pipe.
A088888E02
1
3
5
4
23. REMOVE NO. 2 CAMSHAFT
(a) Using several steps, uniformly loosen and remove
the 11 bearing cap bolts in the sequence shown in
the illustration, and then remove the 5 bearing caps
and No. 2 camshaft.
NOTICE:
Loosen each bolt uniformly, keeping the
camshaft level.
2
A037074E02
24. REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING SPROCKET
(a) Clamp the camshaft in a vise.
(b) Remove the flange bolt and camshaft timing
sprocket.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the camshaft.
A064874E01
2
25. REMOVE CAMSHAFT
(a) Using several steps, uniformly loosen and remove
the 8 bearing cap bolts in the sequence shown in
the illustration, and then remove the 4 bearing caps
and camshaft.
NOTICE:
Loosen each bolt uniformly, keeping the
camshaft level.
4
3
1
A037075E02
Flange Bolt
Do Not Remove
Straight Pin
A050060E02
26. REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING GEAR
(a) Turn the valve timing controller assembly at the
most advanced angle (see page EM-65).
(b) Remove the flange bolt and camshaft timing gear.
NOTICE:
• Be careful not to remove the other 4 bolts.
• If reusing the camshaft timing gear, unlock
the lock pin inside the camshaft timing gear
first.
EM
EM–124
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
3
7
9
6
1
5
10
8
2
4
A035286E02
27. REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD
(a) Using several steps, uniformly loosen and remove
the 10 cylinder head bolts with an 8 mm bi-hexagon
wrench in the sequence shown in the illustration.
Remove the 10 cylinder head bolts and plate
washers.
NOTICE:
• Be careful not to drop washers into the
cylinder head.
• Head warpage or cracking could result from
removing bolts in the incorrect order.
28. REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD GASKET
29. REMOVE OIL FILTER UNION
(a) Using a 12 mm hexagon wrench, remove the oil
filter union.
EM
A088892E02
30. REMOVE NO. 2 OIL PAN
(a) Remove the oil pan drain plug and gasket.
(b) Remove the 9 bolts and 2 nuts.
A088893E01
SST
SST
A088894E02
(c) Insert the blade of SST between the oil pan and No.
2 oil pan, cut off the applied sealer and remove the
No. 2 oil pan.
SST 09032-00100
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the oil pan and No. 2
oil pan.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
EM–125
31. REMOVE OIL STRAINER
(a) Remove the bolt, 2 nuts, oil strainer and gasket.
A084113E01
32. REMOVE OIL PAN
(a) Loosen and remove the 13 bolts uniformly in several
steps.
EM
A088895E01
(b) Using a screwdriver, remove the oil pan by prying
between the cylinder block and oil pan.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the contact surfaces of
the oil pan and cylinder block.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
A088896E01
(c) Remove the 2 O-rings from the cylinder block.
A088897E01
EM–126
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
(d) Using an E5 "torx" socket, remove the 4 stud bolts.
A089042E01
33. REMOVE ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL
EM
A089043E01
34. INSPECT CONNECTING ROD THRUST CLEARANCE
(a) Using a dial indicator, measure the thrust clearance
while moving the connecting rod back and forth.
Standard thrust clearance:
0.16 to 0.36 mm (0.0063 to 0.0142 in.)
Maximum thrust clearance:
0.36 mm (0.0142 in.)
If the thrust clearance is greater than the maximum,
replace the connecting rod.
A084165
35. INSPECT CONNECTING ROD OIL CLEARANCE
(a) Check that the matchmarks on the connecting rod
and cap are aligned to ensure the correct
reassembly.
(b) Using SST, remove the 2 connecting rod cap bolts.
SST 09205-16010
(c) Using the 2 removed connecting rod cap bolts,
remove the connecting rod cap and lower bearing
by wiggling the connecting rod cap right and left.
(d) Clean the crank pin and bearing.
(e) Check the crank pin and bearing for pitting and
scratches.
SST
A084166E01
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
(f)
Plastigage
EM–127
Lay a strip of Plastigage across the crank pin.
A050668E01
(g) Match together the connecting rod and cap in the
correct combination. Then install the cap onto the
connecting rod, making sure that the front mark on
the cap is correctly oriented.
(h) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads of the
connecting rod cap bolts.
Front Mark
A091905E01
(i)
SST
Using SST, tighten the bolts in several steps by the
specified torque.
SST 09205-16010
Torque: 15 N*m (153 kgf*cm, 11 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Do not turn the crankshaft.
A084167E01
90°
Paint Mark
Engine Front
(j) Mark the front of the connecting cap bolts with paint.
(k) Retighten the cap bolts by 90° as shown in the
illustration.
NOTICE:
Do not turn the crankshaft.
(l) Remove the 2 bolts, connecting rod cap and lower
bearing.
A050671E02
(m) Measure the Plastigage at its widest point.
Standard oil clearance:
0.016 to 0.040 mm (0.0006 to 0.0016 in.)
Maximum oil clearance:
0.06 mm (0.0024 in.)
NOTICE:
Completely remove the Plastigage.
A037349E01
EM
EM–128
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
(n) If the oil clearance is greater than the maximum,
select and replace the bearing. If necessary, use an
undersized bearing.
Mark
1 , 2 or 3
Front Mark
A051826E01
Reference
Number Mark
EM
Connecting Rod External
Diameter
Center Bearing Thickness
Oil Clearance
1
43.000 to 43.008 mm (1.6929 to
1.6932 in.)
1.491 to 1.492 mm (0.0587 to
0.0588 in.)
0.016 to 0.040 mm (0.0006 to
0.0016 in.)
2
43.008 to 43.016 mm (1.6932 to
1.6935 in.)
1.492 to 1.496 mm (0.0588 to
0.0589 in.)
0.016 to 0.040 mm (0.0006 to
0.0016 in.)
3
43.016 to 43.024 mm (1.6935 to
1.6939 in.)
1.496 to 1.500 mm (0.0589 to
0.0591 in.)
0.016 to 0.040 mm (0.0006 to
0.0016 in.)
U/S 0.25
43.000 to 43.024 mm (1.6929 to
1.6939 in.)
1.608 to 1.614 mm (0.0633 to
0.0635 in.)
0.016 to 0.040 mm (0.0006 to
0.0016 in.)
A001166E01
36. REMOVE PISTON WITH CONNECTING ROD
(a) Using a ridge reamer, remove all carbon from the
top of the cylinder.
(b) Push the piston, connecting rod assembly and
upper bearing through the top of the cylinder block.
HINT:
• Keep the bearing, connecting rod and cap
together.
• Keep the piston and the connecting rod
assemblies in the correct order so that they can
be returned to their original locations when reassembling.
37. REMOVE CONNECTING ROD BEARING
A084170E01
38. INSPECT CRANKSHAFT THRUST CLEARANCE
(a) Using a dial indicator, measure the thrust clearance
while prying the crankshaft back and forth with a
screwdriver.
Standard thrust clearance:
0.09 to 0.19 mm (0.0035 to 0.0075 in.)
Maximum thrust clearance:
0.30 mm (0.0118 in.)
If the thrust clearance is greater than the maximum,
replace the thrust washers as a set. Check the
crankshaft and block for wear. Repair or replace if
necessary.
HINT:
Thrust washer thickness: 2.43 to 2.48 mm (0.0957
to 0.0976 in.)
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
3
7
9
5
1
4
8
10
6
2
EM–129
39. REMOVE CRANKSHAFT AND INSPECT OIL
CLEARANCE
(a) Using several steps, uniformly loosen and remove
the 10 bearing cap bolts with SST in the sequence
shown in the illustration.
SST 09011-38121
(b) Remove the 5 bearing caps and crankshaft.
(c) Clean each main journal and bearing.
A084171E02
Upper Bearing
Oil Groove
Lower Bearing
Block Side
A
B
(d) Install the upper bearing with the oil groove onto the
cylinder block, and the lower bearing onto the
bearing cap.
NOTICE:
Do not apply engine oil to the contact surfaces
of the cylinder block or the backside of the
bearing.
HINT:
The mass production parts do not have claws as
marks. If reusing the mass production parts,
measure the clearance of both sides with the
bearing in the center of the bearing cap.
Standard clearance:
A - B = within 0.8 mm (0.032 in.)
(e) Install the crankshaft onto the cylinder block.
Cap Side
A
B
Mass Production Part
Claw
Service Part
A091909E02
(f)
Plastigage
A050669E03
Lay a strip of Plastigage across each journal.
EM
EM–130
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
Front Mark
and Number
Front
Mark
Number
No. 3
(g) Check the front marks and numbers and install the
bearing caps onto the cylinder block.
(h) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads of the
bearing cap bolts.
No. 1, 2, 4, 5
A091910E01
(i)
7
3
1
5
9
8
4
2
6
10
EM
Using SST, tighten the bolts in several steps by the
specified torque in the sequence shown in the
illustration.
SST 09011-38121
Torque: 22 N*m (224 kgf*cm, 16 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Do not turn the crankshaft.
A084171E05
90°
Painted
Mark
Engine Front
(j) Mark the front of the bearing cap bolts with paint.
(k) Retighten the bearing cap bolts by 90° in the same
sequence.
(l) Check that the painted mark is now at a 90° angle to
the front.
NOTICE:
Do not turn the crankshaft.
(m) Remove the bearing cap.
A050671E04
(n) Measure the Plastigage at its widest point.
Standard oil clearance:
0.010 to 0.023 mm (0.0004 to 0.0009 in.)
Maximum oil clearance:
0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
NOTICE:
Completely remove the Plastigage.
A037352E03
EM–131
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
No. 1 No. 2 No. 3No. 4 No. 5
HINT:
• If the oil clearance is greater than the maximum,
select and replace the bearing. If necessary, use
an undersized bearing.
• To select the correct bearing size, calculate the
bearing number by adding together the numbers
imprinted on the cylinder block and crank journal.
Example:
Imprinted number on the cylinder block is 3.
Imprinted number on the crank journal is 5. 3 + 5
= 8 Select the bearing with the bearing number 3.
Standard cylinder block diameter
Cylinder Block
Number
Bearing
Number
No. 1
No. 3
No. 5
No. 2
No. 4
Crank Journal Number
A091934E01
Number
Specified Condition
0
50.000 to 50.003 mm (1.9685 to 1.9686 in.)
1
50.003 to 50.005 mm (1.9686 to 1.9687 in.)
2
50.005 to 50.007 mm (1.9687 to 1.9688 in.)
3
50.007 to 50.010 mm (1.9688 to 1.9689 in.)
4
50.010 to 50.012 mm (1.9689 to 1.9690 in.)
5
50.012 to 50.014 mm (1.9690 to 1.9691 in.)
6
50.014 to 50.016 mm (1.96905 to 1.96913 in.)
Standard crankshaft journal diameter
Number
Specified Condition
0
45.998 to 46.000 mm (1.8109 to 1.8110 in.)
1
45.996 to 45.998 mm (1.81086 to 1.81094 in.)
2
45.994 to 45.996 mm (1.8108 to 1.8109 in.)
3
45.992 to 45.994 mm (1.81071 to 1.81079 in.)
4
45.990 to 45.992 mm (1.8106 to 1.8107 in.)
5
45.988 to 45.990 mm (1.81055 to 1.81063 in.)
Reference
Cylinder Block Number +
Crank Journal Number
Bearing Number
Center Bearing Thickness
Oil Clearance
0 to 2
1
1.992 to 1.995 mm (0.0784 to 0.0785 in.)
0.010 to 0.023 mm (0.0004 to
0.0009 in.)
3 to 5
2
1.995 to 1.998 mm (0.0785 to 0.0787 in.)
Same as above
6 to 8
3
1.998 to 2.001 mm (0.0787 to 0.0788 in.)
Same as above
9 to 11
4
2.001 to 2.004 mm (0.0788 to 0.0789 in.)
Same as above
-
U/S 0.25
2.111 to 2.117 mm (0.0831 to 0.0834 in.)
Same as above
40. REMOVE CRANKSHAFT BEARING
41. REMOVE CRANKSHAFT THRUST WASHER
42. REMOVE PISTON RING SET
HINT:
Keep the piston rings in the correct combination and
correct order so that they can be returned to their original
locations when reassembling.
EM
EM–132
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
(a) Using a piston ring expander, remove the 2
compression rings.
(b) Remove the oil ring (side rail and expander) by
hand.
A084172E01
SST
EM
SST
SST
43. REMOVE PISTON PIN
(a) Using SST, press out the piston pin from the piston.
SST 09221-25026 (09221-00021, 09221-00030,
09221-00190, 09221-00141, 09221-00150)
NOTICE:
Keep the pistons, pins, rings, connecting rods
and bearings in the correct order so that they
can be returned to their original locations when
reassembling.
A084173E01
44. REMOVE CYLINDER BLOCK WATER DRAIN COCK
(a) Remove the cylinder block water drain cock from
the cylinder block.
A084175E01
45. REMOVE OIL JET
(a) Remove the oil jet from the cylinder block.
A084179E01
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
EM–133
46. REMOVE STUD BOLT
(a) Remove the stud bolt for the knock control sensor
from the cylinder block.
(b) Using an E5 "torx" socket, remove the 6 stud bolts
from the cylinder block.
A088908E01
Front Side
Intake Side
EM
A092959E02
47. REMOVE RING PIN
(a) Remove the 2 oil pump ring pins from the cylinder
block.
A084194E01
48. REMOVE STRAIGHT PIN
(a) Remove the chain tensioner straight pin from the
cylinder block.
A084195E01
EM–134
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
(b) Remove the 2 cylinder head straight pins from the
cylinder block.
A037182E01
(c) Remove the 2 oil pan straight pins from the cylinder
block.
EM
A084196E01
(d) Remove the 2 end plate straight pins from the
cylinder block.
49. REMOVE TIGHT PLUG
A084197E01
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
EM–135
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT CYLINDER BLOCK FOR FLATNESS (See
page EM-61)
2.
INSPECT CYLINDER BORE
(a) Using a cylinder gauge, measure the cylinder bore
diameter at positions A and B in the thrust and axial
directions.
(b) Calculate the average of the thrust diameter and
axial diameter at position A in the illustration.
(c) Calculate the average of thrust diameter and axial
diameter at position B in the illustration.
Standard diameter:
75.000 to 75.013 mm (2.9528 to 2.9533 in.)
Maximum diameter:
75.133 mm (2.9580 in.)
If either of the 2 average values is greater than the
maximum, replace the cylinder block.
Thrust Direction
Axial Direction
Front
A
B
10 mm
(0.39 in.)
Center
A091907E02
3.
INSPECT PISTON WITH PIN
(a) Using a micrometer, measure the diameter of the
piston. Align the micrometer so it is 37 mm (1.46 in.)
from the top of the piston and at a right angle (90°)
to the piston pin holes.
Standard piston diameter:
74.941 to 74.979 mm (2.9504 to 2.9519 in.)
37 mm
A084180E02
(b) Using a caliper gauge, measure the piston pin hole
diameter of the piston.
Standard piston pin hole diameter:
18.013 to 18.016 mm (0.7092 to 0.7093 in.) at
20°C (68°F)
A084198E01
EM
EM–136
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
(c) Using a micrometer, measure the piston pin
diameter.
Standard piston pin diameter:
18.001 to 18.004 mm (0.7087 to 0.7088 in.)
NOTICE:
Do not change the combination of the piston
and piston pin so that they can be returned to
their original locations when reassembling.
(d) Subtract the piston pin diameter measurement from
the piston pin hole diameter measurement.
Standard oil clearance:
0.009 to 0.015 mm (0.0004 to 0.0006 in.)
Maximum oil clearance:
0.050 mm (0.0020 in.)
If the clearance is greater than the maximum,
replace the bush. If necessary, replace both the
piston and piston pin together.
EM00227E01
EM
4.
INSPECT PISTON CLEARANCE
(a) Subtract the piston diameter measurement from the
cylinder bore diameter measurement.
Standard oil clearance:
0.045 to 0.068 mm (0.0018 to 0.0027 in.)
Maximum oil clearance:
0.08 mm (0.0032 in.)
If the oil clearance is greater than the maximum,
replace all 4 pistons. If necessary, replace the
cylinder block.
5.
INSPECT CONNECTING ROD
(a) Using a caliper gauge, measure the internal
diameter of the connecting rod.
Standard connecting rod inside diameter:
17.965 to 17.985 mm (0.7073 to 0.7081 in.)
If the diameter is not within the range of the
standard inside diameter, replace the connecting
rod.
A001185E01
(b) Using a rod aligner and feeler gauge, check the
connecting rod alignment.
(1) Check for misalignment.
Maximum misalignment:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.) per 100 mm (3.94 in.)
If the misalignment is greater than the
maximum, replace the connecting rod
assembly.
Z000064E01
EM–137
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
(2) Check for twist.
Maximum twist:
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.) per 100 mm (3.94 in.)
If the twist is greater than the maximum,
replace the connecting rod assembly.
Z000065E01
6.
INSPECT RING GROOVE CLEARANCE
(a) Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance
between the new piston ring and the wall of the ring
groove.
Standard ring groove clearance
Item
Specified Condition
No. 1 ring
0.02 to 0.04 mm (0.0008 to 0.0016 in.)
No. 2 ring
0.02 to 0.06 mm (0.0008 to 0.0024 in.)
Oil ring
0.02 to 0.06 mm (0.0008 to 0.0024 in.)
A084181E01
If the clearance is not as specified, replace the
piston.
7.
INSPECT PISTON RING END GAP
(a) Using a piston, push the piston ring a little beyond
the bottom of the ring travel, 110 mm (4.33 in.) from
the top of the cylinder block.
110 mm
A037354E03
(b) Using a feeler gauge, measure the end gap.
Standard end gap
Item
Standard
Maximum
No. 1 ring
0.20 to 0.30 mm (0.0079 to 0.0118 in.)
0.61 mm (0.0240 in.)
No. 2 ring
0.30 to 0.45 mm (0.0118 to 0.0177 in.)
1.20 mm (0.0472 in.)
Oil ring
0.10 to 0.40 mm (0.0039 to 0.0158 in.)
1.15 mm (0.0453 in.)
If the end gap is greater than the maximum, replace
the piston ring and oil ring.
EM07639E01
EM
EM–138
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
8.
INSPECT CONNECTING ROD BOLT
(a) Using a vernier caliper, measure the tension portion
diameter of the bolt.
Standard diameter:
6.6 to 6.7 mm (0.260 to 0.264 in.)
Minimum diameter:
6.4 mm (0.252 in.)
If the diameter is less than the minimum, replace the
bolt.
9.
INSPECT CRANKSHAFT
(a) Using a dial indicator and V-blocks, measure the
circle runout as shown in the illustration.
Maximum circle runout:
0.03 mm (0.0012 in.)
If the circle runout is greater than the maximum,
replace the crankshaft.
A001470E01
EM
A011241E01
A037157E01
ZF06928E01
(b) Inspect the diameter.
(1) Using a micrometer, measure the diameter of
each main journal as illustrated.
Standard diameter:
45.988 to 46.000 mm (1.8106 to 1.8110 in.)
If the diameter is not as specified, replace the
crankshaft.
(2) Calculate the taper and distortion of the main
journal.
Maximum taper and distortion:
0.02 mm (0.0008 in.)
If the taper and distortion are greater than the
maximum, replace the crankshaft.
(3) Using a micrometer, measure the diameter of
each crank pin as illustrated.
Standard diameter:
39.992 to 40.000 mm (1.5745 to 1.5748 in.)
If the diameter is not as specified, replace the
crankshaft.
(4) Calculate the taper and distortion of the crank
pin.
Maximum taper and distortion:
0.02 mm (0.0008 in.)
If the taper and distortion are greater than the
maximum, replace the crankshaft.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
A038171E01
EM–139
(c) Wrap the chain around the timing sprocket as
shown in the illustration.
(d) Using a vernier caliper, measure the timing sprocket
diameter with the chain wrapped.
Standard sprocket diameter (w/ chain):
51.72 mm (2.0362 in.)
Minimum sprocket diameter (w/ chain):
50.5 mm (1.988 in.)
NOTICE:
When measuring the diameter, the vernier
caliper must be in contact with the chain roller.
If the diameter is less than the minimum, replace the
chain and crankshaft.
10. INSPECT CRANKSHAFT BEARING CAP SET BOLT
(a) Using a vernier caliper, measure the tension portion
diameter of the bolt.
Standard diameter:
7.3 to 7.5 mm (0.287 to 0.295 in.)
Minimum diameter:
7.2 mm (0.283 in.)
If the diameter is less than the minimum, replace the
bolt.
A001194E01
EM
EM–140
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
REPLACEMENT
1.
REPLACE OIL PUMP SEAL
HINT:
There are 2 ways to replace the oil seal: remove it with
the timing chain cover removed, or remove it with the
timing chain cover installed.
(a) If the timing chain cover is removed:
(1) Using a screwdriver, remove the oil seal.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
Wooden Block
EM
A035281E06
SST
Wooden
Block
A037153E02
Cut Position
A050694E02
(2) Using SST and a hammer, tap in a new oil seal
until its surface is flush with the timing chain
cover edge.
SST 09950-60010 (09951-00250, 0995100380, 09952-06010), 09950-70010
(09951-07100)
NOTICE:
• Be careful not to tap the oil seal at an
angle.
• Keep the lip free of foreign objects.
(3) Apply multi-purpose grease to the lip of the oil
seal.
(b) If the timing chain cover is installed:
(1) Using a knife, cut off the lip of the oil seal.
(2) Using a screwdriver with the tip wrapped in
tape, pry out the oil seal.
NOTICE:
After removal, check if the crankshaft is not
damaged. If it is damaged, smooth the
surface with 400-grit sandpaper.
(3) Apply multi-purpose grease to the lip of a new
oil seal.
NOTICE:
Keep the lip free of foreign objects.
(4) Using SST and a hammer, tap in the oil seal
until its surface is flush with the timing chain
cover edge.
SST 09223-22010
NOTICE:
• Be careful not to tap the oil seal at an
angle.
• Wipe any extra grease off the crankshaft.
SST
A066485E01
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
2.
Cut Position
EM–141
REPLACE ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL
(a) Using a knife, cut off the lip of the oil seal.
(b) Using a screwdriver with the tip wrapped in tape, pry
out the oil seal.
NOTICE:
After removal, check if the crankshaft is
damaged. If it is damaged, smooth the surface
with 400-grit sandpaper.
A088160E02
(c) Apply multi-purpose grease to the lip of a new oil
seal.
NOTICE:
Keep the lip free of foreign materials.
(d) Using SST and a hammer, tap in the oil seal until its
surface is flush with the rear oil seal retainer edge.
SST 09223-56010
NOTICE:
• Be careful not to tap the oil seal at an angle.
• Wipe any extra grease off the crankshaft.
SST
A088161E01
REASSEMBLY
Adhesive
1.
INSTALL CYLINDER BLOCK WATER DRAIN COCK
(a) Apply adhesive to 2 or 3 threads of the drain cock,
and install it within 3 minutes.
Adhesive:
Toyota Genuine Adhesive 1344, Three Bond
1344 or Equivalent
A054747E04
40q
40q
A098338E01
(b) Tighten the drain cock to the specified torque. Then
rotate the drain cock clockwise until its drain port
faces downward.
Torque: 35 N*m (357 kgf*cm, 26 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
• Install the water drain cock within 3 minutes
of applying adhesive.
• Do not add coolant for at least 1 hour after
installation.
• Do not rotate the drain cock more than 360° in
this step, and never loosen it after setting the
drain cock correctly.
• The pipe of the drain cock should be within
40° of the vertical position.
EM
EM–142
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
2.
Adhesive
INSTALL TIGHT PLUG
(a) Apply adhesive to new tight plugs.
Adhesive:
Toyota Genuine Adhesive 1324, Three Bond
1324 or Equivalent
A058129E03
EM
(b) Using SST, tap in the tight plugs as shown in the
illustration.
SST 09950-60010 (09951-00180), 09950-70010
(09951-07100)
Standard depth:
0.2 to 1.2 mm (0.008 to 0.047 in.)
SST
A037185E01
0.2 to 1.2 mm
A080981E02
3.
8 mm
20 mm
11.5 to 12.5
mm
A091911E02
INSTALL STRAIGHT PIN
(a) Using a plastic-faced hammer, tap in a new end
plate straight pin.
Standard protrusion:
11.5 to 12.5 mm (0.453 to 0.492 in.)
HINT:
• Pin height: 20 mm (0.787 in.)
• Pin diameter: 8 mm (0.315 in.)
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
EM–143
(b) Using a plastic-faced hammer, tap in a new oil pan
straight pin.
Standard protrusion:
8.5 to 9.5 mm (0.335 to 0.374 in.)
HINT:
• Pin height: 18 mm (0.709 in.)
• Pin diameter: 8 mm (0.315 in.)
8 mm
8.5 to 9.5 mm
18 mm
EM
A091912E02
(c) Using a plastic-faced hemmer, tap in a new cylinder
head straight pin.
Standard protrusion:
8.5 to 9.5 mm (0.335 to 0.374 in.)
HINT:
• Pin height: 18 mm (0.709 in.)
• Pin diameter: 8 mm (0.315 in.)
8 mm
8.5 to 9.5 mm
18 mm
A091913E02
(d) Using a plastic-faced hammer, tap in a new chain
tensioner straight pin.
Standard protrusion:
18.5 to 19.5 mm (0.728 to 0.768 in.)
HINT:
• Pin height: 36 mm (1.417 in.)
• Pin diameter: 10 mm (0.394 in.)
10 mm
36 mm
18.5 to 19.5 mm
A091914E02
EM–144
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
8 mm
3.5 to 4.5 mm
8 mm
EM
4.
INSTALL RING PIN
(a) Using a plastic-faced hammer, tap in a new oil pump
ring pin.
Standard protrusion:
3.5 to 4.5 mm (0.134 to 0.177 in.)
HINT:
• Pin height: 8 mm (0.315 in.)
• Pin diameter: 8 mm (0.315 in.)
5.
INSTALL STUD BOLT
(a) Using an E5 "torx" socket, install the 6 stud bolts.
Torque: 5.0 N*m (51 kgf*cm, 44 in.*lbf)
A091915E02
B
C
15.5 mm (0.61 in.)
32.5 mm (1.28 in)
A
A (M6)
15 mm (0.61 in.)
8.5 mm (0.33 in)
B
(M6)
9 mm (0.35 in.)
18 mm (0.70 in.)
8 mm (0.31 in.)
C (M6)
47 mm
(1.85 in.)
12 mm (0.47 in.)
A037223E03
NOTICE:
Make sure that the bottom of the stud bolt
contacts the cylinder block, as shown in the
illustration.
(b) Install the stud bolt for the knock sensor to the
cylinder block.
Torque: 11 N*m (112 kgf*cm, 8 ft.*lbf)
A088908E01
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
EM–145
6.
INSTALL OIL JET
(a) Align the concave of the cylinder block with the
bracket of the oil jet, then tap in the oil jet (the
service part).
NOTICE:
Do not tap the tip of the oil jet.
7.
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT
(a) Install the upper bearing with the oil groove onto the
cylinder block, and the lower bearing onto the
bearing cap.
NOTICE:
Do not apply engine oil to the contact surface of
the cylinder block or the backside of the
bearing.
HINT:
Mass production parts do not have claws as marks.
If reusing the mass production parts, measure the
clearance of both sides with the bearing in the
center of the bearing cap.
Standard clearance:
A - B = within 0.8 mm (0.032 in.)
Align
A091917E01
Upper Bearing
Oil Groove
Lower Bearing
Block Side
A
B
Cap Side
A
B
Mass Production Part
Claw
Service Part
A091909E02
(b) Install the 2 thrust washers onto the No. 3 journal
position of the cylinder block with the oil grooves
facing outward.
(c) Apply engine oil to the upper bearing and install the
crankshaft onto the cylinder block.
Oil Groove
A001191E04
EM
EM–146
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
(d) Check the front marks and numbers and install the
bearing caps onto the cylinder block.
(e) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads of the
bearing cap bolts.
Front Mark and Number
Front Mark
Number
No. 3
No. 1, 2, 4, 5
A050917E02
(f)
7
3
1
5
9
8
4
2
6
10
EM
Using SST, tighten the bolts in several steps by the
specified torque in the sequence shown in the
illustration.
SST 09011-38121
Torque: 22 N*m (224 kgf*cm, 16 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Check that the crankshaft turns smoothly.
A084171E05
(g) Mark the front of the bearing cap bolts with paint.
(h) Retighten the bearing cap bolts by 90° in the same
sequence.
(i) Check that the painted mark is now at a 90° angle to
the front.
Painted
Mark
90°
Engine Front
A050671E04
8.
Front
Mark
INSTALL PISTON PIN
(a) Apply engine oil to the piston pin and the inside
surface of the connecting rod.
(b) Align the front marks of the piston and connecting
rod.
A091919E01
(c) Using SST, push in the piston pin.
SST 09221-25026 (09221-00021, 09221-00030,
09221-00190, 09221-00141, 09221-00150)
NOTICE:
Keep the pistons, pins, rings, connecting rods
and bearings in the correct order so that they
can be returned to their original locations when
reassembling.
SST
SST
SST
A037366E01
EM–147
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
(d) Check the piston pin position.
Specified clearance:
A - B = -0.5 to 0.5 mm (-0.0197 to 0.0197 in.)
B
A
A089103E02
9.
Claw
INSTALL CONNECTING ROD BEARING
(a) Align the bearing claw with the grooves of the
connecting rod and connecting rod cap.
NOTICE:
Do not apply engine oil to the contact surface of
the connecting rod and connecting rod cap and
the backside of the bearing.
A050672E01
10. INSTALL PISTON RING SET
HINT:
If reusing the piston rings, install them onto the matched
pistons with the surfaces facing correctly.
A084172E01
Cord
Mark
Upward
Gap
(a) Install the 2 compression rings and oil ring.
Code mark
Part
Paint Color
Code Mark
No. 1 compression ring
Red
1R
No. 2 compression ring
Blue
2R
Oil ring
-
-
Paint Mark
A091920E01
(b) Position the piston rings so that the ring ends are as
shown in the illustration.
No. 1 Compression Ring
Oil Ring
Front
Front Mark
No. 2 Compression Ring
A091921E02
11. INSTALL PISTON WITH CONNECTING ROD
(a) Apply engine oil to the cylinder walls, pistons, and
the surfaces of the connecting rod bearings.
(b) Check the position of the piston ring ends.
EM
EM–148
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
Front
Mark
Piston Ring
Compressor
A091922E02
(c) Using a piston ring compressor, push the correctly
numbered piston and connecting rod assemblies
into each cylinder with the front mark on the piston
facing forward.
NOTICE:
• Do not apply engine oil to the contact surface
of the connecting rod cap and the backside of
the bearing.
• Match the numbered connecting rod cap with
the correct connecting rod.
(d) Match the connecting rod and cap together in the
correct combination. Then install the cap onto the
connecting rod, making sure that the front mark on
the cap is correctly oriented.
(e) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads of the
connecting rod cap bolts.
Front Mark
EM
A091905E01
(f)
SST
Using SST, tighten the bolts in several steps by the
specified torque.
SST 09205-16010
Torque: 15 N*m (153 kgf*cm, 11 ft.*lbf)
A084167E01
90°
Painted
Mark
Engine Front
A050671E04
(g) Mark the front of the connecting cap bolts with paint.
(h) Retighten the cap bolts by 90° as shown.
(i) Check that the crankshaft turns smoothly.
EM–149
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
12. INSTALL OIL PAN
(a) Using an E5 "torx" socket, install the 4 stud bolts.
B
13 mm
(0.51 in.)
A
22.5 mm
(0.89 in.)
16.5 mm
(0.65 in.)
27.5 mm
(1.08 in.)
Stud Bolt A
(M6)
Stud Bolt B
8 mm
(M6)
(0.31 in.)
9 mm
(0.31 in.)
A050686E02
Torque: 5.0 N*m (51 kgf*cm, 44 in.*lbf)
9 mm
(0.35 in.)
11 mm
(0.43 in.)
Seal Packing
Seal Packing
4 mm
(0.16 in.)
4 mm
(0.16 in.)
(b) Apply a continuous line of seal packing to the oil pan
mating surface as shown in the illustration.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three
Bond 1207B or Equivalent
Standard seal diameter:
2.0 to 3.0 mm (0.079 to 0.118 in.)
NOTICE:
• Remove any oil from the contact surface.
• Install the oil pan within 3 minutes of applying
seal packing.
• Do not expose the seal to engine oil for at
least 2 hours after installation.
A120012E01
(c) Install 2 new O-rings onto the cylinder block.
A088897E01
EM
EM–150
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
3 15
4
5
6
7
14 2
8 1 9
13
10
12
11
A037067E02
(d) Using several steps, install and uniformly tighten the
13 bolts in the sequence shown in the illustration.
Torque: 24 N*m (245 kgf*cm, 18 ft.*lbf)
HINT:
Each bolt length is as follows:
49 mm (1.93 in.) for bolt A
88 mm (3.47 in.) for bolt B
144 mm (5.67 in.) for bolt C
13. INSTALL ENGINE REAR OIL SEAL (See page EM140)
14. INSTALL OIL STRAINER
(a) Install a new gasket and the oil strainer with the 2
nuts and bolt.
Torque: 11 N*m (112 kgf*cm, 8.1 ft.*lbf)
EM
A084113E01
Seal Diameter: 2.5 to 3.5 mm
A081876E03
15. INSTALL NO. 2 OIL PAN
(a) Apply a continuous line of seal packing to the oil pan
mating surface as shown in the illustration.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three
Bond 1207B or Equivalent
Standard seal diameter:
2.5 to 3.5 mm (0.098 to 0.14 in.)
NOTICE:
• Remove any oil from the contact surface.
• Install the oil pan within 3 minutes of applying
seal packing.
• Do not expose the seal to engine oil for at
least 2 hours after installation.
• Do not start the engine within 2 hours of
installation.
(b) Install the No. 2 oil pan with the 9 bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque: 9.0 N*m (92 kgf*cm, 80 in.*lbf)
(c) Install the drain plug with a new gasket.
Torque: 37.5 N*m (382 kgf*cm, 28 ft.*lbf)
A088893E01
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
EM–151
16. INSTALL OIL FILTER UNION
(a) Using a 12 mm hexagon wrench, install the oil filter
union.
Torque: 30 N*m (306 kgf*cm, 22 ft.*lbf)
A088892E02
17. INSTALL OIL FILTER
(a) Check and clean the oil filter installation surface.
(b) Apply clean engine oil to the gasket of a new oil
filter.
(c) Lightly screw the oil filter into place, and tighten it
until the gasket comes into contact with the seat.
(d) Using SST, tighten it an additional 3/4 turn.
SST 09228-06501
If using a torque wrench, tighten to the specified
torque.
Torque: 17.5 N*m (178 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
SST
A088870E01
Lot No.
A092832E02
18. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD GASKET
(a) Place a new cylinder head gasket on the cylinder
block with the Lot No. stamp facing upward.
NOTICE:
• Remove any oil from the contact surface.
• Pay attention to the mounting orientation of
the cylinder head gasket.
• Place the cylinder head on the cylinder block
gently in order not to damage the gasket at
the bottom part of the head.
19. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD
HINT:
The cylinder head bolts are tightened in 2 successive
steps.
Cylinder Head
Diameter:
4.5 to 5.5 mm
Cylinder Head
Gasket
Cylinder Block
Seal Packing
A073748E02
(a) Apply seal packing as shown in the illustration.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three
Bond 1207B or Equivalent
Standard seal diameter:
3.5 to 4.5 mm (0.177 to 0.217 in.)
NOTICE:
• Remove any oil from the contact surface.
• Install the oil pan within 3 minutes of applying
seal packing.
(b) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the threads of the
cylinder head bolts.
EM
EM–152
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
8
4
2
5
10
6
1
3
(c) Using several steps, install and uniformly tighten the
10 cylinder head bolts and plate washers with an 8
mm bi-hexagon wrench in the sequence shown in
the illustration.
Torque: 29 N*m (300 kgf*cm, 22 ft.*lbf)
9
7
A035286E03
90°
EM
(d) Mark the front of the cylinder head bolt with paint.
(e) Retighten the cylinder head bolts by an additional
90° and then another 90°, as shown in the
illustration.
(f) Check that the painted mark is now at a 180° angle
to the front.
90°
Front
Paint Mark
A092833E01
Straight Pin
Groove
A080974E04
20. INSTALL CAMSHAFT TIMING GEAR
(a) Put the camshaft timing gear and camshaft together
so that the straight pin and key groove are offset, as
shown in the illustration.
(b) Turn the camshaft timing gear assembly clockwise
while pushing it lightly towards the camshaft. Push
further at the position where the pin fits into the
groove.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to turn the camshaft timing gear
to the retard angle (to the right).
(c) Check that there is no clearance between the gear
fringe and the camshaft.
(d) Tighten the flange bolt with the camshaft timing gear
fixed in place.
Torque: 64 N*m (653 kgf*cm, 47 ft.*lbf)
(e) Check that the camshaft timing gear can move to
the retard angle (to the right) and is locked in the
most retarded position.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
40q
Timing Mark
EM–153
21. INSTALL CAMSHAFT
(a) Turn the crankshaft by 40° counterclockwise from
TDC/compression.
A092826E01
3
1
2
4
A037103E03
(b) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the camshaft
journals.
(c) Place the camshaft on the cylinder head with the
timing mark on the camshaft timing gear facing
upward.
(d) Examine the front marks and numbers, and tighten
the bolts in the sequence shown in the illustration.
Torque: 13 N*m (129 kgf*cm, 9 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Tighten each bolt uniformly, keeping the
camshaft level.
22. INSTALL CAMSHAFT TIMING SPROCKET
(a) Clamp the camshaft in a vise.
(b) Align the knock pin hole of the camshaft timing
sprocket with the knock pin of the camshaft, and
install the camshaft timing sprocket.
Torque: 64 N*m (653 kgf*cm, 47 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the camshaft.
A032167E01
5
3
1
2
4
No. 1 Bearing Cap
A092834E02
23. INSTALL NO. 2 CAMSHAFT
(a) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the camshaft
journals.
(b) Place the camshaft on the cylinder head with the
timing mark on the camshaft timing gear facing
upward.
(c) Examine the front marks and numbers, and tighten
the bolts in the sequence shown in the illustration.
Torque: 13 N*m (133 kgf*cm, 9 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Tighten each bolt uniformly, keeping the
camshaft level.
(d) Install the No. 1 bearing cap.
Torque: 23 N*m (235 kgf*cm, 17 ft.*lbf)
24. INSTALL CHAIN (See page EM-35)
25. INSTALL OIL PUMP SEAL (See page EM-138)
EM
EM–154
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
26. INSTALL TIMING CHAIN COVER
(a) Remove any old packing material from the contact
surface.
(b) Install 2 new O-rings onto the 2 locations as shown
in the illustration.
(c) Apply seal packing to the oil pump assembly,
cylinder head and cylinder block as shown in the
illustration below.
A088881E01
Seal Packing
Seal Packing
EM
B
B
A
A
C
Seal Packing
C
Seal Packing
(Water Pump Part)
Diameter:
A-A
1.5 to 2.0 mm
(0.059 to 0.078 in.)
2.5 mm
(0.098 in.)
B - B, C - C
(After Assembling)
2.5 mm (0.098 in.) or more
5.0 mm
(0.197 in.)
B - B, C - C
1.5 mm
(0.059 in.)
2.5 mm
(0.098 in.)
Other Part
Seal Diameter:
3.5 to 4.5 mm (0.138 to 0.177 in.)
Diameter:
1.5 to 2.0 mm (0.059 to 0.078 in.)
3.5 to 4.5 mm Water Pump Part
Seal Diameter:
(0.138 to
0.177 in.)
3.5 to 4.5 mm (0.138 to 0.177 in.)
1.0 mm
(0.039 in.)
1.0 mm
(0.039 in.)
1.5 to 2.0 mm (0.059 to 0.078 in.)
A117400E03
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
EM–155
Seal packing:
Water pump part: Toyota Genuine Adhesive
1324, Three Bond 1324 or Equivalent
Other part: Toyota Genuine Seal Packing
Black, Three Bond 1207B or Equivalent
NOTICE:
• Remove any oil from the contact surface.
• Install the oil pump within 3 minutes of
applying seal packing.
• Do not expose the seal to engine oil for at
least 2 hours after installation.
• Do not start the engine for at least 2 hours
after installation.
(d) Align the keyway of the oil pump drive rotor with the
rectangular portion of the crankshaft, and slide the
oil pump into place.
A035284E01
D
E
A
A
C
C
C
B
C
A037150E01
(e) Install the oil pump assembly with the 15 bolts and
nut. Uniformly tighten the bolts and nut in several
steps.
Torque: 32 N*m (326 kgf*cm, 24 ft.*lbf) for bolt A
11 N*m (112 kgf*cm, 8.1 ft.*lbf) for bolt
B
11 N*m (112 kgf*cm, 8.1 ft.*lbf) for bolt
C
24 N*m (245 kgf*cm, 18 ft.*lbf) for nut D
24 N*m (245 kgf*cm, 18 ft.*lbf) for bolt E
NOTICE:
• Be careful not to disturb the seal packing.
• After installing the timing chain case, install
the mounting bracket and water pump within
15 minutes.
HINT:
Each bolt length is as follows:
30 mm (1.18 in.) for bolt A
35 mm (1.38 in.) for bolt B
20 mm (0.79 in.) for bolt C
20 to 14 mm (0.79 to 0.55 in.) for bolt E
EM
E M – 1 5 6
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
A088879E01
27. INSTALL CRANKSHAFT PULLEY
(a) Install the crankshaft straight pin to the crankshaft.
(b) Align the hole of the crankshaft pulley with the
straight pin, then install the crankshaft pulley.
(c) Using SST, hold the crankshaft pulley and tighten
the crankshaft bolt.
SST 09213-58013 (91111-50845), 09330-00021
Torque: 128 N*m (1,305 kgf*cm, 95 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
When installing SST, be careful that the bolt
which holds SST does not interfere with the
chain cover.
28. INSTALL WATER PUMP
(a) Install a new gasket and the water pump with the 3
bolts and 2 nuts.
Torque: 11 N*m (112 kgf*cm, 8 ft.*lbf)
EM
A088890E01
29. INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET RH
(a) Install the engine mounting bracket RH with the 4
bolts.
Torque: 55 N*m (561 kgf*cm, 41 ft.*lbf)
30. INSPECT VALVE CLEARANCE (See page EM-7)
31. ADJUST VALVE CLEARANCE (See page EM-9)
A088876
32. INSTALL FUEL INJECTOR
(a) Install new insulators onto each fuel injector.
(b) Apply a light coat of spindle oil or gasoline to new Orings and install them onto each fuel injector.
(c) Apply a light coat of spindle oil or gasoline to the
place where a delivery pipe comes into contact with
the O-ring.
Insulator
O-Ring
A050145E01
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
Connector
Turn
EM–157
(d) While turning the injector clockwise and
counterclockwise, install it to the delivery pipe.
NOTICE:
• Be careful not to twist the O-ring.
• After installing the fuel injectors, check that
they turn smoothly. If not, reinstall it with a
new O-ring.
Push
33. INSTALL FUEL DELIVERY PIPE
(a) Install the 2 spacers onto the cylinder head.
A050146E01
(b) Install the fuel delivery pipe and 4 fuel injectors
together.
Torque: 19 N*m (194 kgf*cm, 14 ft.*lbf) for bolt A
9.0 N*m (92 kgf*cm, 80 in.*lbf) for bolt B
NOTICE:
• Be careful not to drop the fuel injectors when
installing the fuel delivery pipe.
• Check that the fuel injectors rotate smoothly
after installing the fuel delivery pipe.
A
B
A089809E02
Seal Packing
11
9
A050172E01
7
5
10
1
8
3
2
6
4
A035756E02
34. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVER
(a) Install the gasket onto the cylinder head cover.
(b) Apply seal packing to the 2 locations shown in the
illustration.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three
Bond 1207B or Equivalent
NOTICE:
• Remove any oil from the contact surface.
• Install the cylinder head cover within 3
minutes of applying seal packing.
• Do not start the engine for at least 2 hours
after installation.
(c) Install the cylinder head cover with the 9 bolts, 2
seal washers and 2 nuts.
(d) Using several steps, uniformly tighten the bolts and
nuts in the sequence shown in the illustration.
Torque: 10 N*m (102 kgf*cm, 7 ft.*lbf)
EM
EM–158
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
35. INSTALL VENTILATION VALVE
(a) Install the ventilation valve onto the cylinder head
cover.
Torque: 27 N*m (275 kgf*cm, 20 ft.*lbf)
36. INSTALL OIL FILLER CAP
(a) Install a new gasket and the oil filler cap.
A080963E02
EM
SST
37. INSTALL WATER PUMP PULLEY
(a) Temporarily install the water pump pulley with the 3
bolts.
(b) Using SST, tighten the 3 bolts.
SST 09960-10010 (09962-01000, 09963-00600)
Torque: 15 N*m (153 kgf*cm, 11 ft.*lbf)
A086914E01
38. INSTALL CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the O-ring on the
sensor.
NOTICE:
If the O-ring is damaged, replace the sensor.
(b) Install the sensor with the bolt.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (76 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
A088874E02
39. INSTALL THERMOSTAT
(a) Install a new gasket onto the thermostat.
(b) Install the thermostat with the jiggle valve facing
upward.
HINT:
The jiggle valve may be set within 10° on either side
as shown in the illustration.
10° 10°
Jiggle Valve
A092977E01
(c) Install the water inlet with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 9.0 N*m (92 kgf*cm, 80 in.*lbf)
A088871E01
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL – ENGINE UNIT
EM–159
40. INSTALL CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE
ASSEMBLY
(a) Apply a light coat of engine oil to a new O-ring, and
install it onto the oil control valve.
(b) Install the oil control valve with the bolt.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (76 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Be careful not to twist the O-ring.
A088869E02
41. INSTALL CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Apply engine oil to the O-ring.
NOTICE:
If the O-ring is damaged, replace the sensor.
(b) Install the sensor with the bolt.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
A088868E02
42. INSTALL SPARK PLUG
(a) Using a 16 mm plug wrench, install the 4 spark
plugs.
Torque: 18 N*m (184 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
EM
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–1
SFI SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
1.
PRECAUTIONS FOR HIGH-VOLTAGE CIRCUIT
INSPECTION AND SERVICE
(a) Technicians to be engaged in inspection and service
on high-voltage components and systems should
receive special training.
(b) All the high-voltage wire harness connectors are
colored orange: the HV battery and other highvoltage components and identified by the "High
Voltage" caution labels.
Do not touch these connectors and components
before removing the service plug. Remove the
service plug prior to touching these connectors and
components.
(c) Before inspecting or servicing the high-voltage
components/systems, be sure to take safe
precautions such as wearing insulated gloves and
removing the service plug to prevent electric shock
or electrocution. Store the removed service plug in
your pocket to prevent other technicians from
reinstalling it while you are serving high-voltage
components/systems.
(d) After removing the service plug, wait at least for 5
minutes before touching any of the high-voltage
connectors and terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes is required to discharge electricity
from the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
A083545
A086958
(e) Before wearing insulted gloves, make sure that they
are not rupture, torn or damaged in any other way.
Do not wear wet insulated gloves.
(f) When servicing, be careful not to drop metallic
materials like a mechanical pencil or tools etc.
Causing a short circuit may result.
(g) Wear the insulated gloves before touching a bare
high-voltage terminal. Verify that electricity has
discharged from the terminal (approximately 0 V)
using an electrical tester.
ES
ES–2
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(h) After disconnecting or exposing a high-voltage
connector or terminal, insulate it immediately using
insulation tape.
(i) The screw of a high-voltage terminal should be
tightened firmly to the specified torque. Either
insufficient or excessive tightening torque can cause
HV system failure.
(j) Call other technicians' attention to prevent accidents
during working on the high-voltage components/
systems by posting a sign to notify them (see page
IN-5).
(k) Prior to reinstalling the service plug, again, verify
whether or not any parts or tools have been left
behind, and check if high-voltage terminal screws
have been securely tightened as well as the
connectors have been properly reconnected.
A086959
ES
2.
PRECAUTIONS TO BE OBSERVED WHEN
INSPECTING OR SERVICING ENGINE
COMPARTMENT
The PRIUS automatically turns the engine ON and OFF
when the power switch is ON (READY lamp on the
instrument panel is being illuminated). Turn the HV main
system OFF before serving inside the engine
compartment.
3.
INSPECTION
HINT:
When the A/C compressor operation is not required, the
engine is warmed up, and the battery is charged
properly, the PRIUS automatically stops the engine while
the vehicle is at rest. In the case of a continuous engine
operation is needed for performing engine maintenance,
activate inspection mode. Inspection mode enables the
engine to run continuously.
A082796
A082839
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
A082837
4.
ES–3
Activating inspection mode (not using the intelligent
tester)
Perform the following steps from (1) through (4) in 60
seconds.
(1) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(2) Fully repress the accelerator pedal twice with the
transmission in the P position.
(3) Fully depress the accelerator pedal twice with the
transmission in the N position.
(4) Fully depress the accelerator pedal twice with the
transmission in the P position.
(5) Check that the HV system warning lamp flashes on
the multi-information display.
(6) Start the engine by pushing the power switch,
depressing the brake pedal.
Activate inspection mode (Using the intelligent tester)
(1) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(3) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(4) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD /
MOBD / HV ECU / ACTIVE TEST / INSPECTION MODE
/ ON.
(5) Check that the HV system warning flashes on the
multi-information display and the master warning lamp is
illuminated in the combination meter.
(6) Start the engine by pushing the power switch,
depressing the brake pedal.
Deactivating inspection mode
(1) Turn the power switch OFF. The HV main system
turns off simultaneously.
NOTICE:
• The idling speed in inspection mode is
approximately 1,000 rpm. The engine speed
increases to 1,500 rpm if the accelerator pedal is
depressed by less than 60%. If the accelerator
pedal is depressed by more than 60%, the engine
speed increases to 2,500 rpm.
• If a DTC us set during inspection mode, the
master warning lamp and the error warming lamp
illuminate on the multi-information display.
• When the master warning lamp illuminates during
inspection mode, deactivate inspection mode,
and check a DTC(s).
• Driving the vehicle without deactivating
inspection mode may damage the transaxle.
FOR USING FOR OBD II SCAN TOOL OR
INTELLIGENT TESTER
CAUTION:
Observe the following items for safety reasons:
• Read its instruction books before using the scan
tool or the tester.
• Prevent the tester cable from being caught on the
pedals, shift lever and steering wheel when
driving the tester connected to the vehicle.
ES
ES–4
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
5.
• When driving the vehicle for testing purposes
using the scan tool or the tester, two persons are
required. One is for driving the vehicle, and the
other operates the tester.
INITIALIZATION
NOTICE:
When disconnecting the negative (-) battery cable,
initialize the following systems after the terminal is
reconnected.
System Name
See page
Power Window Control System
IN-32
ES
6.
HINT:
Initialization can not be completed by only removing the
battery.
NOTICES FOR HYBRID SYSTEM ACTIVATION
• When the warning lamp is illuminated or the battery
has been disconnected and reconnected, pressing
the switch may not start the system on the first try. If
so, press the power switch again.
• With the power switch's power mode changed to ON
(IG), disconnect the battery. If the key is not in the key
slot during connection, DTC B2779 may be output.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–5
DEFINITION OF TERMS
Terms
Definitions
Monitor description
Description of what the ECM monitors and how it detects malfunctions (monitoring purpose
and its details).
Related DTCs
A group of diagnostic trouble codes that are output by ECM based on same malfunction
detection logic.
Typical enabling condition
Preconditions that allow ECM to detect malfunctions. With all preconditions satisfied, ECM
sets DTC when monitored value(s) exceeds malfunction threshold(s).
Sequence of operation
Order of monitor priority, applied if multiple sensors and components are involved in single
malfunction detection process. Each sensor and component monitored in turn and not
monitored until previous detection operation completed.
Required sensor/components
Sensors and components used by ECM to detect each malfunction.
Frequency of operation
Number of times ECM checks for each malfunction during each driving cycle. "Once per
driving cycle" means ECM only performs checks for that malfunction once during single
driving cycle. "Continuous" means ECM performs checks for that malfunction whenever
enabling conditions are met.
Duration
Minimum time for which ECM must detect continuous deviation in monitored value(s) in
order to set DTC. Timing begins when Typical Enabling Conditions are met.
Malfunction thresholds
Value beyond which ECM determines malfunctions exist and sets DTCs.
MIL operation
Timing of MIL illumination after malfunction detected. "Immediate" means ECM illuminates
MIL as soon as malfunction detected. "2 driving cycle" means ECM illuminates MIL if same
malfunction detected second time during next sequential driving cycle.
ES
ES–6
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
PRESSURE SWITCHING VALVE
FUEL TANK PRESSURE SENSOR
TRAP CANISTER WITH PUMP MODULE
COMBINATION METER
ES
ENGINE ROOM NO. 2 RELAY BLOCK
- CHS W/P RELAY
CANISTER FILTER
ECM
PURGE VSV
CANISTER
FUEL TANK
WATER VALVE
COOLANT HEAT STORAGE TANK
AND WATER PUMP
DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
- IGN FUSE
DLC3
ENGINE ROOM NO. 1 RELAY BLOCK
- C/OPN RELAY (INTEGRATION RELAY) - EFI RELAY (INTEGRATION RELAY)
- IG2 RELAY (INTEGRATION RELAY)
- AM2 FUSE
- EFI FUSE
A127726E01
ES–7
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
MASS AIR FLOW METER
CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL
VALVE ASSEMBLY
ES
IGNITION COIL
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
ENGINE COOLANT
TEMPERATURE SENSOR
THROTTLE BODY
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
KNOCK SENSOR
FUEL INJECTOR
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
A127727E01
ES–8
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
ECM
Injector
Crankshaft
Position Sensor
NE+
G2
Camshaft
Position Sensor
ES
NEVC
Throttle
Position
Sensor
VTA
#10
Injector
#20
IG2
Injector
#30
Injector
#40
Ignition Coil
(#1)
IGT1
IGF
VTA2
ECT Sensor
IGT2
Ignition Coil
(#2)
IGT3
Ignition Coil
(#3)
IGT4
Ignition Coil
(#4)
THW
Vapor Pressure Sensor
PTNK
Mass Air Flow Meter
E2
THA
+B
VG
EVG
Heated Oxygen Sensor
OCV+
Oil Control Valve
OCV-
HT1B
A1A+
A/F Sensor
+B
A1A-
+B
Fuel Pump
OX1B
+B
C/OPN
FC
EVP1
TBP
HA1A
Purge VSV
Pressure Switching Valve
Knock Sensor
TAM
KNK1
EKNK
Oil Pressure Switch
MOPS
E2
Outside Air Temperature Sensor
W
MIL
IG2
A129017E01
ES–9
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ECM
Throttle Control Motor
ETCS
EFI
EFI M
+BM
M+
BATT
M-
+B
GE01
MREL
NEO
ES
HV ECU
GO
DC/DC OBD
DLC3
TC
CAN Communication
CANH
CANL
CHS Tank Outlet Temperature Sensor
THW2
P/I
E2
IG2
AM2
CHS W/P
IGN
+B
IGSW
Water Pump
WPL
Water Valve
MAIN
Power Source
ECU
WSL1
WSL2
(Control Motor and
Valve Position
Sensor )
WBAD
FAN
VC
E2
Fan Relay
Canister Pump Module
ME01
E01
E02
E03
VPMP
MPMP
E04
E1
+B
PPMP
VC
E2
A129018E01
ES–10
ES
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ECM
HV ECU
Body ECU
Transponder Key
ECU
Skid Control ECU
Power Steering
ECU
Combination
Meter ECU
Certification Key
ECU
Steering Sensor
Yaw Rate Sensor
Air Conditioner
Amplifier ECU
Battery ECU
Gateway ECU
BEAN
CAN
DLC3
EMV
AVC LAN
A129019E01
COMMUNICATIONS
The ECM communicates with the following ECM and ECUs
using the signals listed below. The following table explains
receiving and sending signals by ECM or ECU.
Transmit To
Receive From
Signal
Communication Line
HV ECU
ECM
•
•
•
•
•
Inspection mode signal
MIL illumination requirement
Shift position information
Ready state
Starter ON
CAN
ECM
HV ECU
•
•
•
•
•
Ambient temperature
Intake air temperature
Radiator fan drive
Engine warm-up requirement
Engine rpm
CAN
ECM
Battery ECU
•
Engine rpm
CAN
ECM
Power Steering ECU
•
Inspection mode
CAN
ECM
Skid Control ECU
•
Inspection mode
CAN
ECM
Body ECU
•
•
Inspection mode
Engine rpm
BEAN, CAN
Combination Meter ECU
ECM
•
Fuel level
BEAN, CAN
ECM
Combination Meter ECM
•
•
•
•
•
Engine coolant temperature
Engine rpm
Injection volume
Inspection mode
Engine oil pressure switch
BEAN, CAN
ES–11
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Transmit To
Receive From
Signal
Communication Line
ECM
Air Conditioner Amplifier ECU
•
•
•
•
BEAN, CAN
Engine coolant temperature
Engine rpm
Ambient temperature
Coolant heat storage water
valve close
ECM
Certification ECU
•
Engine rpm
BEAN, CAN
ECM
EMV
•
•
•
Engine coolant temperature
Inspection mode
Engine oil pressure switch
ACV LAN, CAN
ES
ES–12
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
*: Use the intelligent tester.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
ES
2
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS
NEXT
3
CONNECT INTELLIGENT TESTER TO DLC3*
HINT:
If the display indicates a communication fault in the tester,
inspect DLC3.
NEXT
4
CHECK DTC AND FREEZE FRAME DATA*
HINT:
Record or print DTCs and freeze frame data, if needed.
NEXT
5
CLEAR DTC AND FREEZE FRAME DATA*
NEXT
6
VISUAL INSPECTION
NEXT
7
NEXT
SETTING CHECK MODE DIAGNOSIS*
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
8
ES–13
PROBLEM SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION
If the engine does not start, first perform the "CHECK DTC"
procedures and "CONDUCT BASIC INSPECTION"
procedures below.
Malfunction does not occur
A
Malfunction occurs
B
B
GO TO STEP 10
A
9
ES
SYMPTOM SIMULATION
NEXT
10
DTC CHECK*
Malfunction code
A
No code
B
B
GO TO STEP 12
A
11
DTC CHART
NEXT
GO TO STEP 14
12
BASIC INSPECTION
Wrong parts not confirmed
A
Wrong parts confirmed
B
B
GO TO STEP 17
A
13
PERFORM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Wrong circuit confirmed
A
Wrong parts confirmed
B
ES–14
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
B
GO TO STEP 17
A
14
CHECK ECM POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT
NEXT
15
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
ES
Malfunction not confirmed
A
Malfunction confirmed
B
B
A
16
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
NEXT
GO TO STEP 18
17
PARTS INSPECTION
NEXT
18
IDENTIFICATION OF PROBLEM
NEXT
19
ADJUSTMENT AND/OR REPAIR
NEXT
20
NEXT
END
CONFIRMATION TEST
GO TO STEP 18
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–15
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT
PROBLEMS
HINT:
Inspect the vehicle's ECM using check mode. Intermittent
problems are easier to detect with the intelligent tester when
the ECM is in check mode. In check mode, the ECM uses 1
trip detection logic, which is more sensitive to malfunctions
than normal mode (default), which uses 2 trip detection logic.
1. Clear the DTCs (see page ES-29).
2. Switch the ECM from normal mode to check mode using
the intelligent tester (see page ES-32).
3. Perform a simulation test (see page IN-36 ).
4. Check and wiggle the harness(es), connector(s) and
terminal(s) (see page IN-45).
5. Wiggle the harness(s) and connector(s) (see page IN-45).
ES
ES–16
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
BASIC INSPECTION
When the malfunction is not confirmed by the DTC check,
troubleshooting should be carried out in all circuits
considered to be possible causes of the problem. In many
cases, by carrying out the basic engine check shown in the
following flowchart, the location of the problem can be found
quickly and efficiently. Therefore, using this check is essential
when engine troubleshooting.
1
CHECK BATTERY VOLTAGE
NOTICE:
Perform this check with the engine stopped and power
switch OFF.
ES
NG
Result
Proceed to
11 V or more
OK
Below 11 V
NG
CHARGE OR REPLACE BATTERY
OK
2
CHECK WHETHER ENGINE WILL CRANK
NG
PROCEED TO PROBLEM SYMPTOMS
TABLE
OK
3
CHECK WHETHER ENGINE STARTS
NG
GO TO STEP 6
OK
4
CHECK AIR FILTER
(a) Visually check that the air filter is not excessively
contaminated with dirt or oil.
NG
REPLACE AIR FILTER
NG
PROCEED TO PROBLEM SYMPTOMS
TABLE
OK
5
CHECK IDLING SPEED
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–17
OK
PROCEED TO PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
6
CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
NG
PROCEED TO TROUBLESHOOTING
OK
7
ES
CHECK FOR SPARK
NG
OK
PROCEED TO PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
PROCEED TO TROUBLESHOOTING
ES–18
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECKING MONITOR STATUS
ES
The purpose of the monitor result (mode 06) is to allow
access to the results for on-board diagnostic monitoring tests
of specific components/systems that are not continuously
monitored. Examples are catalyst, evaporative emission
(EVAP) and thermostat.
The monitor result allows the OBD II scan tool to display the
monitor status, test value, minimum test limit and maximum
test limit. These data are displayed after the vehicle has been
driven to run the monitor.
When the test value is not between the minimum test limit
and maximum test limit, the ECM (PCM) interprets this as a
malfunction. When the component is not malfunctioning, if the
difference of the test value and test limit is very small, the
component will malfunction in the near future.
Perform the following instruction to view the monitor status.
Although this instruction references the Lexus/Toyota
diagnostic tester, it can be checked using a generic OBD II
scan tool. Refer to your scan tool operator's manual for
specific procedures.
1. PERFORM MONITOR DRIVE PATTERN
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch and intelligent tester ON.
(c) Clear the DTCs (see page ES-29).
(d) Run the vehicle in accordance with the applicable
drive pattern described in READINESS MONITOR
DRIVE PATTERN (see page ES-17). DO NOT turn
the power switch OFF.
NOTICE:
The test results will be lost if the power switch is
turned OFF.
2. ACCESS MONITOR RESULT
(a) Select from the intelligent tester menus:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / MONITOR
INFO and MONITOR RESULT. The monitor status
appears after the component name.
• INCMPL: The component has not been
monitored yet.
• PASS: The component is functioning normally.
• FAIL: The component is malfunctioning.
(b) Confirm that the component is either PASS or FAIL.
(c) Select the component and press ENTER. The
accuracy test value appears if the monitor status is
either PASS or FAIL.
3. CHECK COMPONENT STATUS
(a) Compare the test value with the minimum test limit
(MIN LIMIT) and maximum test limit (MAX LIMIT).
ES–19
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
4.
(b) If the test value is between the minimum test limit
and maximum test limit, the component is
functioning normally. If not, the component is
malfunctioning. The test value is usually significantly
higher or lower than the test limit. If the test value is
on the borderline of the test limits, the component
will malfunction in near future.
HINT:
The monitor result might on rare occasions be
PASS even if the malfunction indicator lamp (MIL) is
illuminated. This indicates the system malfunctioned
on a previous driving cycle. This might be caused by
an intermittent problem.
MONITOR RESULT INFORMATION
If you use a generic scan tool, multiply the test value by
the scaling value listed below.
A/F Sensor Bank Sensor 1
Monitor ID
Test ID
Scaling
Unit
Description
$01
$8E
Multiply by 0.0003
No dimension
A/F sensor deterioration
level
HO2S Bank Sensor 2
Monitor ID
Test ID
Scaling
Unit
Description
$02
$07
Multiply by 0.001
V
Minimum sensor voltage
$02
$08
Multiply by 0.001
V
Maximum sensor voltage
$02
$8F
Multiply by 0.0003
g
Maximum oxygen storage
capacity
Monitor ID
Test ID
Scaling
Unit
Description
$21
$A9
Multiply by 0.0003
No dimension
Oxygen storage capacity
of catalyst bank 1
Monitor ID
Test ID
Scaling
Unit
Description
$3D
$C9
Multiply by 0.001
kPa
Test value for small leak
(P0456)
$3D
$CA
Multiply by 0.001
kPa
Test value for gross leak
(P0455)
$3D
$CB
Multiply by 0.001
kPa
Test value for leak
detection pump OFF
stuck (P2401)
$3D
$CD
Multiply by 0.001
kPa
Test value for leak
detection pump ON stuck
(P2402)
$3D
$CE
Multiply by 0.001
kPa
Test value for vent valve
OFF stuck (P2420)
$3D
$CF
Multiply by 0.001
kPa
Test value for vent valve
ON stuck (P2419)
$3D
$D0
Multiply by 0.001
kPa
Test value for reference
orifice low flow (P043E)
$3D
$D1
Multiply by 0.001
kPa
Test value for reference
orifice high flow (P043F)
$3D
$D4
Multiply by 0.001
kPa
Test value for purge VSV
close stuck (P0441)
$3D
$D5
Multiply by 0.001
kPa
Test value for purge VSV
open stuck (P0441)
Catalyst - Bank 1
EVAP
ES
ES–20
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Monitor ID
Test ID
Scaling
Unit
Description
$3D
$D7
Multiply by 0.001
kPa
Test value for purge flow
insufficient (P0441)
Misfire
ES
Monitor ID
Test ID
Scaling
Unit
Description
$A1
$0B
Multiply by 1
Time
Exponential Weighted
Moving Average (EWMA)
misfire for all cylinders:
Misfire counts for last ten
driving cycles - Total
$A1
$0C
Multiply by 1
Time
Misfire rate for all
cylinders: Misfire counts
for last/current driving
cycle - Total
$A2
$0B
Multiply by 1
Time
EWMA misfire for cylinder
1: Misfire counts for last
ten driving cycles - Total
$A2
$0C
Multiply by 1
Time
Misfire rate for cylinder 1:
Misfire counts for last/
current driving cycle Total
$A2
$0C
Multiply by 1
Time
Misfire rate for cylinder 1:
Misfire counts for last/
current driving cycle Total
$A3
$0C
Multiply by 1
Time
Misfire rate for cylinder 2:
Misfire counts for last/
current driving cycle Total
$A4
$0B
Multiply by 1
Time
EWMA misfire for cylinder
3: Misfire counts for last
ten driving cycles - Total
$A4
$0C
Multiply by 1
Time
Misfire rate for cylinder 3:
Misfire counts for last/
current driving cycle Total
$A5
$0B
Multiply by 1
Time
EWMA misfire for cylinder
4: Misfire counts for last
ten driving cycles - Total
$A5
$0C
Multiply by 1
Time
Misfire rate for cylinder 4:
Misfire counts for last/
current driving cycle Total
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–21
READINESS MONITOR DRIVE
PATTERN
1.
PURPOSE OF THE READINESS TESTS
• The On-Board Diagnostic (OBD II) system is
designed to monitor the performance of emissionrelated components, and report any detected
abnormalities with Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs).
Since various components need to be monitored
during different driving conditions, the OBD II system
is designed to run separate monitoring programs
called readiness monitors.
• The intelligent tester's software must be version 9.0 or
newer to view the readiness monitor status.
From the "Enhanced OBD II Menu", select "Monitor
Status" to view the readiness monitor status.
• A generic OBD II scan tool can also be used to view
the readiness monitor status.
• When the readiness monitor status reads "completer",
the necessary conditions have been met for running
performance tests for that readiness monitor.
HINT:
Many state inspection and Maintenance (IM)
programs require a vehicle's readiness monitor status
to show "complete".
• The Readiness Monitor will be reset to "incomplete" if:
– The ECM has lost battery power or a fuse has
blown.
– DTCs have been cleared.
– The conditions for running the Readiness Monitor
have been met.
• If the readiness monitor status shows "incomplete",
follow the appropriate readiness monitor drive pattern
to change the status to "complete".
CAUTION:
Strictly observe of posted speed limits, traffic laws, and
road condition when performing these drive patterns.
NOTICE:
The following drive patterns are the fastest method of
completing all the requirements necessary for making
the readiness monitor status read "complete".
If forced to momentarily stop a drive pattern due to traffic
or other factors, the drive pattern can be resumed. Upon
completion of the drive pattern, in most cases, the
readiness monitor status will change to "complete".
Sudden changes in vehicle loads and speeds, such as
driving up and down hills and / or sudden acceleration,
hinder readiness monitor completion.
ES
ES–22
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
2.
CATALYST MONITOR (A/F SENSOR TYPE)
88 km/h (55 mph)
70 km/h (44 mph)
ES
Idling
Power Switch OFF
Warm up time
(idle speed)
4 minutes
16 minutes
A082401E08
(a) Preconditions
The monitor will not run unless:
• MIL is OFF.
• Engine Coolant Temperature (ECT) is 80°C
(176°F) or greater.
• Intake Air Temperature (IAT) is -10°C (14°F) or
greater.
NOTICE:
To complete the readiness test in cold ambient
conditions (less than -10°C [14°F]), turn the
power switch OFF and then turn it ON again.
Perform the drive pattern a second time.
(b) Drive Pattern
(1) Connect the intelligent tester or OBD II scan tool
to DLC3 to check readiness monitor status and
preconditions.
(2) Put the engine in inspection mode (see page
ES-1).
(3) Start the engine and warm it up.
(4) Drive the vehicle at 70 to 88 km/h (44 to 55 mph)
for approximately 4 minutes (the engine must be
run during monitoring).
NOTICE:
Drive with smooth throttle operation and
avoid sudden acceleration.
If IAT was less than 10°C (50°F) when the
engine was started, drive the vehicle at 70 to
88 km/h (44 to 55 mph) for additional 4
minutes.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–23
(5) Drive the vehicle allowing speed to fluctuate
between 70 to 88 km/h (44 to 55 mph) for about
16 minutes.
NOTICE:
Drive with smooth throttle operation and
avoid sudden closure of the throttle valve.
(6) Check the status of the readiness monitor on the
scan tool display. If readiness monitor status did
not switch to complete, verify that the
preconditions are met, turn the power switch
OFF, and then repeat steps (4) and (5).
3. EVAP MONITOR (KEY OFF TYPE)
(a) Preconditions
The monitor will not run unless:
– The fuel tank is less than 90% full.
– The altitude is less than 8,000 ft (2,450 m).
– The vehicle is stationary.
– The engine coolant temperature is 4.4 to 35°C
(40 to 95°F).
– The intake air temperature is 4.4 to 35°C (40 to
95°F).
– Vehicle was driven in an urban area (or on a
freeway) for 10 minutes or more.
(b) Monitor Conditions
(1) Turn the power switch OFF and wait for 6 hours.
HINT:
Do not start the engine until checking Readiness
Monitor status. If the engine is started, the step
described above must be repeated.
(c) Monitor Status
(1) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and turn the
tester ON.
(3) Check the Readiness Monitor status displayed
on the tester.
If the status does not switch to COMPL (complete), restart the
engine, make sure that the preconditions have been met, and
then perform the Monitor Conditions again.
ES
ES–24
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
4.
OXYGEN / AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR MONITOR
(FRONT A/F SENSOR AND REAR O2S SYSTEM)
88 km/h (55 mph)
(under 3,200 rpm)
70 km/h (44 mph)
(over 1,100 rpm)
Warm up time
ES
Idling
Power Switch OFF
(Idle speed)
5 to 10 minutes
A092806E04
(a) Preconditions
The monitor will not run unless:
MIL is OFF
(b) Drive Pattern
(1) Connect the intelligent tester or OBD II scan tool
to DLC3 to check monitor status and
preconditions.
(2) Put the engine in inspection mode.
(3) Start the engine and allow it to idle for 2 minutes.
(4) Deactivate the inspection mode and drive the
vehicle at 70 to 88 km/h (44 to 55 mph) or more
for 5 to 10 minutes.
(5) Check the readiness monitor status. If the
readiness monitor status did not switch to
"complete", check the preconditions, turn the
power switch OFF, and then repeat steps (1) to
(4).
NOTICE:
Do not drive the vehicle without deactivating inspection
mode, otherwise damaging the transaxle may result.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
5.
ES–25
OXYGEN / A/F SENSOR HEATER MONITOR
40 km/h
(25 mph)
ES
Idling
Power Switch OFF
Over 500 seconds
Over 2 minutes
A078886E18
(a) Preconditions
The monitor will not run unless:
MIL is OFF.
(b) Drive Pattern
(1) Connect the intelligent tester or OBD II scan tool
to DLC3 to check monitor status and
preconditions.
(2) Put the engine in inspection mode.
(3) Start the engine and allow it to idle for 500
seconds or more.
(4) Deactivate the inspection mode and drive the
vehicle at 40 km/h (25 mph) or more at least for
2 minutes.
(5) Check the readiness monitor status. If the
readiness monitor status did not change to
"complete", check the preconditions, turn the
power switch OFF, and repeat steps (2) and (3).
NOTICE:
Do not drive the vehicle without deactivating inspection
mode, otherwise damaging the transaxle may result.
ES–26
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
When the malfunction is not confirmed in the diagnostic
trouble code check and the problem still can not be confirmed
in the basic inspection, use this table and troubleshoot
according to the priority order given below.
Symptom
Engine does not crank (Does not start)
ES
No initial combustion (Does not start)
No complete combustion (Does not start)
Engine cranks normally but difficult to start
Difficult to start with cold engine
Difficult to start with hot engine
High engine idle speed (Poor idling)
Low engine idle speed (Poor idling)
Rough idling (Poor idling)
Hunting (Poor idling)
Suspected area
See page
1. No. 1 Motor generator
-
2. Hybrid control system
HV-20
3. Immobiliser
EI-5
4. Smart key system
ST-66
1. ECM power source circuit
ES-412
2. Fuel pump control circuit
ES-423
3. Spark plug
IG-5
4. Immobiliser system
EI-5
5. Injector
FU-15
6. ECM
ES-24
7. Crankshaft position sensor circuit
ES-159
8. VC output circuit
ES-418
1. Fuel pump control circuit
ES-423
2. Spark plug
IG-5
3. Immobiliser system
EI-5
4. Injector
FU-15
5. Crankshaft position sensor circuit
ES-159
1. Fuel pump control circuit
ES-423
2. Compression
EM-1
3. Spark plug
IG-5
4. Injector
FU-15
5. Crankshaft position sensor circuit
ES-159
1. Fuel pump control circuit
ES-423
2. Spark plug
IG-5
3. Injector
FU-15
4. Crankshaft position sensor circuit
ES-159
1. Fuel pump control circuit
ES-423
2. Spark plug
IG-5
3. Injector
FU-15
4. Crankshaft position sensor circuit
ES-159
1. ECM power source circuit
ES-412
2. Electronic throttle control system
ES-329
1. Fuel pump control circuit
ES-423
2. Electronic throttle control system
ES-329
3. Injector
FU-15
1. Compression
EM-1
2. Electronic throttle control system
ES-329
3. Injector
FU-15
4. Fuel pump control circuit
ES-423
5. Spark plug
IG-5
1. ECM power source circuit
ES-412
2. Electronic throttle control system
ES-329
3. Fuel pump control circuit
ES-423
ES–27
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Symptom
Hesitation/Poor acceleration (Poor driveability)
Surging (Poor driveability)
Engine stalls soon after starting
Unable to refuel/Difficult to refuel
Suspected area
See page
1. Fuel pump control circuit
ES-423
2. Injector
FU-15
3. Spark plug
IG-5
4. HV transaxle
-
1. Fuel pump control circuit
ES-423
2. Spark plug
IG-5
3. Injector
FU-15
1. Fuel pump control circuit
ES-423
2. Electronic throttle control system
ES-329
3. Immobiliser
EI-5
4. Crankshaft position sensor circuit
ES-159
1. ORVR system
-
ES
ES–28
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
TERMINALS OF ECM
E4
E5
E7
E6
ES
A066714E38
Each ECM terminal's standard voltage is shown in the table
below.
In the table, first follow the information under "Condition".
Look under "Symbols (Terminals No.)" for the terminals to be
inspected. The standard voltage between the terminals is
shown under "STD voltage".
Use the illustration above as a reference for the ECM
terminals.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
STD Voltage (V)
BATT (E7-6) - E1 (E5-28)
R - BR
Battery
Always
9 to 14
+B (E7-4) - E1 (E5-28)
B - BR
Power source of ECM
Power switch ON (IG)
9 to 14
+BM (E7-5) - E1 (E5-28)
GR - BR
Power source of ETCS
Always
9 to 14
IGSW (E6-9) - E1 (E5-28)
O - BR
Power switch signal
Power switch ON (IG)
9 to 14
MREL (E7-7) - E1 (E5-28)
G - BR
Main relay control signal
Power switch ON (IG)
9 to 14
VC (E4-18) - E2 (E4-28)
R - BR
Power source of sensor (a
specific voltage)
Power switch ON (IG)
4.5 to 5.5
NE+ (E4-33) - NE- (E4-34) R - G
Crankshaft position sensor Idling (during inspection
mode)
Purge generation
(See page ES-159)
G2 (E4-26) - NE- (E4-34)
R-G
Camshaft position sensor
Idling (during inspection
mode)
Purge generation
(See page ES-159)
VTA (E4-32) - E2 (E4-28)
P - BR
Throttle position sensor
Power switch ON (IG),
Throttle valve fully closed
0.5 to 1.2
VTA (E4-32) - E2 (E4-28)
P - BR
Throttle position sensor
HV system ON, During
active test to open throttle
valve (see page ES-33)
3.2 to 4.8
VTA2 (E4-31) - E2 (E4-28)
L - BR
Throttle position sensor
Power switch ON (IG),
Accelerator pedal
released
2.0 to 2.9
VTA2 (E4-31) - E2 (E4-28)
L - BR
Throttle position sensor
HV system ON, During
active test to open throttle
valve (see page ES-33)
4.6 to 5.5
VG (E5-33) - EVG (E5-32)
G-R
Mass air flow meter
Idling (during inspection
mode), A/C switch OFF
1.0 to 1.5
THA (E4-20) - E2 (E4-28)
W - BR
Intake air temperature
sensor
Idling (during inspection
mode), Intake air
temperature at 20°C
(68°F)
0.5 to 3.4
ES–29
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
STD Voltage (V)
THW (E4-19) - E2 (E4-28)
W - BR
Engine coolant
temperature sensor
Idling (during inspection
mode), Engine coolant
temperature at 80°C
(176°F)
0.2 to 1.0
#10 (E4-2) - E01 (E4-7)
Y - BR
Injector
Power switch ON (IG)
9 to 14
#20 (E4-3) - E01 (E4-7)
B - BR
Injector
Power switch ON (IG)
9 to 14
#30 (E4-4) - E01 (E4-7)
L - BR
Injector
Power switch ON (IG)
9 to 14
#40 (E4-5) - E01 (E4-7)
R - BR
Injector
Power switch ON (IG)
9 to 14
IGT1 (E4-8) - E1 (E5-28)
Y - BR
Ignition coil No. 1 (#1)
(Ignition signal)
Idling (during inspection
mode)
Pulse generation
(See page ES-167)
IGT2 (E4-9) - E1 (E5-28)
W - BR
Ignition coil No. 1 (#2)
Ignition signal)
Idling (during inspection
mode)
Pulse generation
(See page ES-167)
IGT3 (E4-10) - E1 (E5-28)
G - BR
Ignition coil No. 1 (#3)
Ignition signal)
Idling (during inspection
mode)
Pulse generation
(See page ES-167)
IGT4 (E4-11) - E1 (E5-28)
Y - BR
Ignition coil No. 1 (#4)
Ignition signal)
Idling (during inspection
mode)
Pulse generation
(See page ES-159)
KNK1 (E5-1) - EKNK (E52)
B-W
Knock sensor
Idling (during inspection
mode)
Pulse generation
(See page ES-154)
IGF (E4-23) - E1 (E5-28)
B - BR
Ignition confirmation signal
Idling (inspection mode)
Pulse generation
(See page ES-167)
A1A+ (E5-23) - E1 (E5-28)
G - BR
A/F sensor
Power switch ON (IG)
3.0 to 3.6
A1A- (E5-22) - E1 (E5-28)
R - BR
A/F sensor
Power switch ON (IG)
2.7 to 3.3
OX1B (E6-22) - E2 (E428)
Y - BR
Heated oxygen sensor
Maintain engine speed at
2,500 rpm for 2 minutes
after warming up
Pulse generation
HA1A (E5-7) - E04 (E4-1)
Y - BR
A/F sensor heater
Idling (during inspection
mode)
Below 3.0
HA1A (E5-7) - E04 (E4-1)
Y - BR
A/F sensor heater
Power switch ON (IG)
9 to 14
HT1B (E6-6) - E03 (E6-7)
G - BR
Heated oxygen sensor
heater
Idling (during inspection
mode)
Below 3.0
HT1B (E6-6) - E03 (E6-7)
G - BR
Heated oxygen sensor
heater
Power switch ON (IG)
9 to 14
PTNK (E7-34) - E2 (E428)
Y - BR
Vapor pressure sensor
Power switch ON (IG)
2.9 to 3.7
PTNK (E7-34) - E2 (E428)
Y - BR
Vapor pressure sensor
Apply vacuum 4.0 kPa
Below 0.5
EVP1 (E5-14) - E1 (E5-28)
R - BR
EVAP VSV
Power switch ON (IG)
9 to 14
TBP (E7-18) - E1 (E5-28)
R - BR
Tank bypass VSV
Power switch ON (IG)
9 to 14
M+ (E5-6) - E1 (E5-28)
L - BR
Throttle actuator control
motor
Idling (during inspection
mode)
Pulse generation
M- (E5-5) - E1 (E5-28)
P - BR
Throttle actuator control
motor
Idling (during inspection
mode)
Pulse generation
OCV+ (E4-15) - OCV- (E414)
Y-W
Camshaft timing oil control
Power switch ON (IG)
Pulse generation
(See page ES-55)
TAM (E7-21) - E2 (E4-28)
W - BR
Outside air temperature
sensor
Ambient air temperature
40 to 140°C (-40 to 284°F)
0.8 to 1.3
MOPS (E5-15) - E1 (E528)
Y - BR
Engine oil pressure
Power switch ON (IG), not
engine running
9 to 14
WBAD (E7-20) - E1 (E528)
R - BR
Water valve position signal
Power switch ON (IG)
0.3 to 4.7
THW2 (E7-33) - E2 (E428)
W - BR
Coolant heat storage tank
outlet temperature sensor
Power switch ON (IG),
Coolant temperature at
80°C (176°F)
0.2 to 1.0
WSL1 (E7-24) - WSL2
(E7-23)
Y-V
Water valve motor
Changing valve position
Pulse generation
WPL (E7-15) - E1 (E5-28)
V - BR
CHS water pump
Pre-heat mode
0 to 2
ES
ES–30
ES
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
STD Voltage (V)
FAN (E7-8) - E1 (E5-28)
LG - BR
Cooling fan relay
Power switch ON (IG),
Engine coolant
temperature less than
94.5°C (202°F)
9 to 14
W (E6-18) - E1 (E5-28)
LG - BR
MIL
Idling (during inspection
mode)
9 to 14
W (E6-18) - E1 (E5-28)
LG - BR
MIL
Power switch ON (IG)
Below 3.0
FC (E6-10) - E1 (E5-28)
G - BR
Fuel pump control
Power switch ON (IG)
9 to 14
FC (E6-10) - E1 (E5-28)
G - BR
Fuel pump control
Power switch ON (IG)
Below 3.0
TC (E6-14) - E1 (E5-28)
P - BR
Terminal TC of DLC3
Power switch ON (IG)
9 to 14
NEO (E7-1) - E1 (E5-28)
LG - BR
Revolution signal
Idling (during inspection
mode)
Pulse generation
GO (E7-2) - E1 (E5-28)
Y - BR
Revolution signal
Idling (during inspection
mode)
Pulse generation
CANH (E6-31) - E1 (E528)
B - BR
CAN communication line
Power switch ON (IG)
Pulse generation
CANL (E6-30) - E1 (E528)
W - BR
CAN communication line
Power switch ON (IG)
Pulse generation
VPMP (E7-26) - E1 (E528)
V - BR
Vent valve (built into pump
module)
Power switch ON (IG)
9 to 14
MPMP (E7-13) - E1 (E528)
P - BR
Vacuum pump (built into
pump module)
Vacuum pump OFF
0 to 3
MPMP (E7-13) - E1 (E528)
P - BR
Vacuum pump (built into
pump module)
Vacuum pump ON
9 to 14
PPMP (E7-30) - E1 (E528)
L - BR
Pressure sensor (built into
pump module)
Power switch ON (IG)
3 to 3.6
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–31
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
1.
FI00534
Intelligent Tester
DLC3
CAN VIM
A082795E01
2.
3.
DESCRIPTION
When troubleshooting On-Board Diagnostics (OBD II)
vehicles, the intelligent tester (complying with SAE
J1987) must be connected to the Data Link Connector 3
(DLC3) of the vehicle. Various data in the vehicle's
Engine Control Module (ECM) can then be read.
OBD II regulations require that the vehicle's on-board
computer illuminates the Malfunction Indicator Lamp
(MIL) on the instrument panel when the computer
detects a malfunction in:
(a)The emission control systems components
(b)The power train control components (which affect
vehicle emissions)
(c) The computer itself
In addition, the applicable Diagnostic Trouble Codes
(DTCs) prescribed by SAE J2012 are recorded in the
ECM memory. If the malfunction does not reoccur in 3
consecutive trips, the MIL turns off automatically but the
DTCs remain recorded in the ECM memory.
To check the DTCs, connect the intelligent tester to the
DLC3. The tester displays DTCs, freeze frame data, and
a variety of engine data. The DTCs and freeze frame
data can be erased with the tester. In order to enhance
OBD function on vehicles and develop the Off-Board
diagnosis system, the Controller Area Network (CAN)
communication is used in this system. It minimizes the
gap between technician skills and vehicle technology.
CAN is a network which uses a pair of data transmission
lines that span multiple ECUs and sensors. It allows high
speed communication between the systems and
simplifies the wire harness connections. The CAN
Vehicle Interface Module (CAN VIM) must be connected
with the intelligent tester to display any information from
the ECM. The intelligent tester and ECM uses CAN
communication signals to communicate. Connect the
CAN VIM between the intelligent tester and DLC3.
NORMAL MODE AND CHECK MODE
The diagnosis system operates in normal mode during
normal vehicle use. In normal mode, 2 trip detection
logic is used to ensure accurate detection of
malfunctions. Check mode is also available as an option
for technicians. In check mode, 1 trip detection logic is
used for simulating malfunction symptoms and
increasing the system's ability to detect malfunctions,
including intermittent problems (intelligent tester only).
2 TRIP DETECTION LOGIC
When a malfunction is first detected, the malfunction is
temporarily stored in the ECM memory (1st trip). If the
same malfunction is detected during the next
subsequent drive cycle, the MIL is illuminated (2nd trip).
ES
ES–32
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
4.
FREEZE FRAME DATA
Freeze frame data records the engine conditions (fuel
system, calculated engine load, engine coolant
temperature, fuel trim, engine speed, vehicle speed,
etc.) when malfunctions are detected. When
troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if
the vehicle was moving or stationary, if the engine was
warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or rich,
and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
Priorities for troubleshooting:
If troubleshooting priorities for multiple DTCs are given in
the applicable DTC chart, these priorities should be
followed.
If no instructions are given, perform troubleshooting for
those DTCs according to the following priorities.
(a)DTCs other than fuel trim malfunction (DTCs P0171
and P0172) and misfire (P0300 to P0304).
(b)Fuel trim malfunction (DTCs P0171 and P0172).
(c) Misfire (DTCs P0300 to P0304).
5.
DATA LINK CONNECTOR 3 (DLC3)
The vehicle's ECM uses the ISO 15765-4 for
communication protocol. The terminal arrangement of
the DLC3 complies with SAE J1962 and matches the
ISO 15765-4 format.
ES
DLC3
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 1112131415 16
A082779E98
Symbols
Terminal No.
Names
Reference terminal
Results
Condition
SIL
7
Bus "+" line
5 - Signal ground
Pulse generation
During transmission
CG
4
Chassis ground
Body ground
1 Ω or less
Always
SG
5
Signal ground
Body ground
1 Ω or less
Always
BAT
16
Battery positive
Body ground
9 to 14 V
Always
CANH
6
CAN "High" line
CANL
54 to 69 Ω
Power switch OFF
CANH
6
CAN "High" line
Battery positive
1 MΩ or higher
Power switch OFF
CANH
6
CAN "High" line
CG
1 kΩ or higher
Power switch OFF
CANL
14
CAN "Low" line
Battery positive
1 MΩ or higher
Power switch OFF
CANL
14
CAN "Low" line
CG
1 kΩ or higher
Power switch OFF
If the result is not as specified, the DLC3 may have a
malfunction. Repair or replace the harness and
connector.
HINT:
When you use the intelligent tester or OBD scan tool,
first connect its cable to the DLC3. Next, turn ON the
main power of the PRIUS by pushing the power switch
ON (IG). Finally turn the tester or the scan tool ON. If the
screen displays UNABLE TO CONNECT TO VEHICLE,
a problem exists in the vehicle side or the tester side.
If communication is normal when the tester is connected
to another vehicle, inspect the DLC3 of the original
vehicle.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–33
If communication is still not possible when the tester is
connected to another vehicle, the problem may be in the
tester itself. Consult the Service Department listed in the
tester's instruction manual.
6. BATTERY VOLTAGE
Battery Voltage:
11 to 14 V
If the voltage is below 11 V, recharge or replace the
battery before proceeding.
7. MIL (Malfunction Indicator Lamp)
(a) The MIL is illuminated when the power switch is first
turned ON (the engine is not running).
(b) When the HV main system is activated (READY
ON), the MIL should turn off. If the MIL illuminates
gain, the diagnosis system has detected
malfunction or abnormality in the system.
HINT:
If the MIL is not illuminated when the power switch is first
turned ON (IG), check the MIL circuit (see page ES-428 ).
8. ALL READINESS
For the vehicle, using the intelligent tester allows
readiness codes corresponding to all DTCs to be read.
When diagnosis (normal or malfunctioning) has been
completed, readiness codes are set. Enter the following
menus on the intelligent tester: ENHANCED OBD II /
MONITOR STATUS.
ES
ES–34
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC CHECK / CLEAR
NOTICE:
• If no DTC appears in normal mode:
On the OBD II or intelligent tester, check the pending
fault code using the Continuous Test Results function
(Mode 7 for SAE J1979).
• When the diagnosis system is changed from normal
mode to check mode or vice versa, all DTCs and
freeze frame data recorded in normal mode are
erased. Before changing modes, always check and
make a note of DTCs and freeze frame data.
HINT:
• DTCs which are stored in the ECM can be displayed on
the intelligent tester. The intelligent tester can display
current and pending DTCs.
• Some DTCs are not set if the ECM does not detect the
same malfunction again during a second consecutive
driving cycle. However, malfunctions detected on only 1
occasion are stored as pending DTCs.
ES
1.
Intelligent Tester
DLC3
CAN VIM
A082795E01
CHECK DTC (Using Intelligent Tester)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and turn the tester
ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT
CODES.
(d) Check the DTC(s) and freeze frame data, and then
write them down.
(e) Check the details of the DTC(s) (see page ES-42).
NOTICE:
Turn the HV main system OFF (IG OFF) after the
symptom is simulated once. Then repeat the simulation
process again. When the problem has been simulated
again, the MIL illuminates and the DTCs are recorded in
the ECM.
2. CLEAR DTC (Using Intelligent Tester)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and turn the tester
ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / CLEAR CODES.
(d) Press the YES button.
NOTICE:
Clearing the DTCs will also clear the freeze frame data,
detailed information and operation history data.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–35
3.
CLEAR DTC (Without Using Intelligent Tester)
(a) Remove the EFI and ETCS fuses from the engine
room relay block from more than 60 seconds, or
disconnecting the battery cable for more than 60
seconds.
NOTICE:
When disconnecting the battery cable, perform the
"INITIALIZE" procedure (see page IN-32).
ETCS Fuse
EFI Fuse
A082798E03
ES
ES–36
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
FREEZE FRAME DATA
DESCRIPTION
The freeze frame data records the engine condition (fuel
system, calculated load, engine coolant temperature, fuel
trim, engine speed, vehicle speed, etc.) when malfunction is
detected. When troubleshooting, it can help determine if the
vehicle was running or stopped, the engine was warmed up
or not, the air-fuel ratio was LEAN or RICH and other data. at
the time of the malfunction occurred.
HINT:
If it is impossible to replicate the problem even though a DTC
is detected, confirm the freeze frame data.
ES
List of freeze frame data
LABEL
(Intelligent Tester Display)
Measure Item/Range
Diagnostic Note
CALC LOAD
Calculate load
Calculated load by ECM
COOLANT TEMP
Engine coolant temperature
If the value is -40°C, sensor circuit is open
If the value is 140°C, sensor circuit is shorted
SHORT FT #1
Short-term fuel trim
Short-term fuel compensation used to
maintain the air-fuel ratio at stoichiometric airfuel ratio
LONG FT #1
Long-term fuel trim
Overall fuel compensation carried out in longterm to compensate a continual deviation of
the short-term fuel trim from the central valve
ENGINE SPD
Engine speed
-
VEHICLE SPD
Vehicle speed
Speed indicated on speedometer
IGN ADVANCE
Ignition advance
-
INTAKE AIR
Intake air temperature
If the value is -40°C, sensor circuit is open
If the value is 140°C, sensor circuit is shorted
MAF
Mass air flow volume
If the value is approximately 0.0 g/sec.:
• Mass air flow meter power source circuit
• VG circuit open or short
If the value is 160.0 g/sec. or more:
• E2G circuit open
THROTTLE POS
Throttle position
O2S B1 S2
Heated oxygen sensor output
Performing the INJ VOL or A/F CONTROL
function of the ACTIVE TEST enables the
technician to check voltage output of the
sensor
O2FT B1 S2
Fuel trim at heated oxygen sensor
Same as SHORT FT #1
ENG RUN TIME
Accumulated engine running time
-
AF FT B1 S1
Fuel trim at A/F sensor
-
AFS B1 S1
A/F sensor output
Performing the INJ VOL or A/F CONTROL
function of the ACTIVE TEST enables the
technician to check voltage output of the
sensor
EVAP PURGE VSV
EVAP purge VSV duty ratio
-
Read the value with the power switch ON (Do
not start engine)
DIST DTC CLEAR
Accumulated distance from DTC cleared
-
CAT TEMP B1 S1
Catalyst temperature
-
CAT TEMP B1 S2
Catalyst temperature
-
BATTERY VOLTAGE
Battery voltage
-
AIR-FUEL RATIO
Air-fuel ratio
-
THROTTLE POS
Throttle sensor positioning
Read the value with the power switch ON (Do
not start engine)
AMBIENT TEMP
Ambient air temperature
If the value is -40°C, sensor circuit is open
If the value is 140°C, sensor circuit is shorted
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
LABEL
(Intelligent Tester Display)
Measure Item/Range
Diagnostic Note
THROTTLE POS #2
Throttle sensor positioning #2
-
THROTTLE MOT
Throttle motor
-
TIME DTC CLEAR
Cumulative time after DTC cleared
-
KNOCK CRRT VAL
Correction learning value of knocking
-
ES–37
KNOCK FB VAL
Feedback value of knocking
-
PURGE DENSITY
Learning value of purge density
-
EVAP PURGE FLOW
Purge flow
-
FC IDL
Idle fuel cut
ON: when throttle valve fully closed and
engine speed is over 1,500 rpm
FC TAU
FC TAU
The fuel cut is being performed under very
light load to prevent the engine combustion
from becoming incomplete
VVTL AIM ANGL #1
VVT aim angle
-
VVT CHNG ANGL #1
VVT change angle
-
VVT OCV DUTY B1
VVT OCV operation duty
-
INI COOL TEMP
Initial engine coolant temperature
-
INI INTAKE TEMP
Initial intake air temperature
-
INJ VOL
Injection volume
-
INJECTOR
Injector
-
TOTAL FT #1
Total fuel trim
-
MISFIRE RPM
Misfire RPM
-
MISFIRE LOAD
Misfire load
-
CYL #1
Cylinder #1 misfire rate
Displayed in only idling
CYL #2
Cylinder #2 misfire rate
Displayed in only idling
CYL #3
Cylinder #3 misfire rate
Displayed in only idling
CYL #4
Cylinder #4 misfire rate
Displayed in only idling
CYL ALL
All cylinder misfire rate
Displayed in only idling
IGNITION
Ignition
-
MISFIRE MARGIN
Misfire monitoring
-
ENG OIL PRES SW
Engine oil pressure switch signal
Always ON while engine is running
ES
ES–38
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK MODE PROCEDURE
HINT:
Intelligent tester only:
Compared to normal mode, check mode has more sensing
ability to detect malfunction. Furthermore, the same
diagnostic items which are detected in normal mode can also
be detected in check mode.
1.
Intelligent Tester
ES
DLC3
CAN VIM
CHECK MODE PROCEDURE (Using Intelligent
Tester)
(a) Check the initial conditions.
(1) Battery positive voltage 11 V or more
(2) Throttle valve fully closed
(3) Shift position in the P or N
(4) A/C switched OFF
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
A082795E01
0.13 seconds
ON
OFF
0.13 seconds
A076900E04
(d) Change the ECM to check mode using the
intelligent tester. Make sure the MIL flashes as
shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
All DTCs and freeze frame data recorded will be
erased if: 1) the intelligent tester is used to
change the ECM from normal mode to check
mode or vice-versa, or 2) during check mode,
the power switch is switched from ON (IG) to ON
(ACC) or OFF.
(e) Start the HV main system (READY ON). The MIL
should turn off after the system starts.
(f) Simulate the condition of the malfunction described
by the customer.
(g) After simulating the malfunction conditions, check
DTCs, freeze frame data and other data using the
tester.
(h) After checking DTCs, inspect applicable circuits.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–39
FAIL-SAFE CHART
If any of the following codes are recorded, the ECM enters
fail-safe mode.
DTC No.
Fail-safe Operation
Fail-safe Deactivation Conditions
P0031
P0032
P0037
P0038
Heater is turned OFF
Power switch OFF
P0100
P0102
P0103
Ignition timing is calculated from engine
speed and throttle angle
"Pass" condition detected
P0110
P0112
P0113
Intake air temperature is fixed at 20°C (68°F)
"Pass" condition detected
P0115
P0117
P0118
Engine coolant temperature is fixed at 80°C
(176°F)
"Pass" condition detected
P0120
P0122
P0123
Fuel cut intermittently and drive on motor
mode
Power switch OFF
P0121
Fuel cut intermittently and drive on motor
mode
Power switch OFF
P0325
Maximum ignition timing retardation
Power switch OFF
P0351
P0352
P0353
P0354
Fuel cut and drive on motor mode
Power switch OFF
P0657
VTA is fixed at about 16% and fuel cut
intermittently and drive on motor mode
Power switch OFF
P1115
P1117
P1118
Engine coolant temperature is fixed at 80°C
(176°F)
"Pass" condition detected
P1120
P1122
P1123
Water valve position is fixed at position when
DTC is detected
"Pass" condition detected
P2102
P2103
VTA is fixed at about 16% and fuel cut
intermittently
Power switch OFF
P2119
VTA is fixed at about 16% and fuel cut
intermittently
"Pass" condition detected and power switch
OFF
P3190
P3191
P3193
Drive on motor mode
Power switch OFF
ES
ES–40
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST
1.
ES
DATA LIST
HINT:
Using the intelligent tester DATA LIST allows switch,
sensor, actuator and other item values to be read without
removing any parts. Reading DATA LIST early in
troubleshooting is one way to shorten labor time.
NOTICE:
In the table below, the values listed under "Normal
Condition" are reference values. Do not depend
solely on these reference values when deciding
whether a part is faulty or not.
(a) Turn the power switch ON (READY) and warm up
the engine.
(b) Turn the power switch OFF.
(c) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(e) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(f) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST.
(g) According to the display on the tester, read items in
DATA LIST.
Intelligent tester Display
Measurement Item/Range
(Display)
Normal Condition*
Diagnostic Note
INJECTOR
Injection period of the No. 1
cylinder/
Min.: 0 ms, Max.: 32.64 ms
Idling: 1 to 3 ms
(Inspection mode)
-
IGN ADVANCE
Ignition timing advance for No. 1
cylinder/
Min.: -64 deg., Max.: 63.5 deg.
Idling: BTDC 7 to 15°
(Inspection mode)
-
CALC LOAD
Calculated load by ECM/
Min.: 0%, Max.: 100%
•
-
•
Idling: 10 to 20% (Inspection
mode)
Running without load (1,500
rpm): 10 to 20%
VEHICLE LOAD
Vehicle load:
Min.: 0 %, Max.: 25,700 %
Actual vehicle load
-
MAF
Air flow rate from MAF meter/
Min.: 0 g/sec., Max.: 655.35 g/
sec.
Idling: 3 to 7 g/sec. (1,500 rpm)
If the value is approximately 0.0
g/sec.:
• Mass air flow meter power
source circuit open
• VG circuit open or short If the
value is 160.0 g/sec. or more:
• E2G circuit open
ENGINE SPD
Engine speed/
Min.: 0 rpm, Max.: 16,383 rpm
Idling 1,000 rpm
(when putting the engine in
inspection mode)
-
VEHICLE SPD
Vehicle speed/
Min.: 0 km/h, Max.: 255 km/h
Actual vehicle speed
Speed indicated on speedometer
COOLANT TEMP
Engine coolant temperature/
Min.: -40°C, Max.: 140°C
After warming up: 80 to 100°C
(176 to 212°F)
•
•
INTAKE AIR
Intake air temperature/
Min.: -40°C, Max.: 140°C
Equivalent to ambient air
temperature
•
•
AIR-FUEL RATIO
Air-fuel ratio:
Min.: 0, Max.: 1.999
During idling: 1,500 rpm
0.8 to 1.2
-
If the value is -40°C (-40°F):
sensor circuit is open
If the value is 140°C (284°F):
sensor circuit is shorted
If the value is -40°C (-40°F):
sensor circuit is open
If the value is 140°C (284°F):
sensor circuit is shorted
ES–41
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Intelligent tester Display
Measurement Item/Range
(Display)
Normal Condition*
Diagnostic Note
AMBIENT TEMP
Ambient air temperature/
Min.: -40°C, Max.: 215°C
Equivalent to ambient air
temperature
•
•
If the value is -40°C:
sensor circuit is open
If the value is 215°C:
sensor circuit is shorted
PURGE DENSITY
Learning value of purge density/
Min.: -50, Max.: 350
-40 to 0%
Idling (Inspection mode)
Service data
EVAP PURGE FLOW
Purge flow/
Min.: 0%, Max.: 102.4%
Idling: 0 to 100%
-
EVAP PURGE VSV
EVAP (Purge) VSV control duty/
Min.: 0%, Max.: 100%
0 to 100%
During idling: 1,500 rpm
Order signal from ECM
VAPOR PRES TANK
Vapor pressure/
Min.: -4.125 kPa, Max.: 2.125 kPa
Fuel tank cap removed: 0 kPa
Pressure inside fuel tank is
monitored by the vapor pressure
sensor
VAPOR PRES PUMP
Vapor pressure:
Min.: 33.853 kPa, Max.: 125.596
kPa
Approximately 100 kPa:
Power switch ON (IG)
EVAP system pressure monitored
by canister pressure sensor
VAPOR PRES CALC
Vapor pressure (calculated):
Min.: -5.632 kPa, Max.: 715.264
kPa
Approximately 100 kPa:
Power switch ON (IG)
EVAP system pressure monitored
by canister pressure sensor
KNOCK CRRT VAL
Correction learning value of
knocking/
Min.: -64 CA, Max.: 1,984 CA
0 to 22°CA
Driving: 70 km/h (44 mph)
Service data
KNOCK FB VAL
Feedback value of knocking/
Min.: -64 CA, Max.: 1,984 CA
-22 to 0°CA
Driving: 70 km/h (44 mph)
Service data
CLUTCH
Clutch current:
Min.: 0 A, Max.: 2.49 A
-
-
ETCS MAG CLUTCH
Electromagnetic Clutch:
ON or OFF
-
-
ACCEL IDL POS
Whether or not accelerator pedal
position sensor is detecting idle/
ON or OFF
Idling: ON
(inspection mode)
-
THRTL LEARN VAL
Throttle valve fully closed
(learned value)
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 5 V
0.4 to 0.8 V
-
FAIL #1
Whether or not fail safe function
is executed/ ON or OFF
ETCS has failed: ON
-
FAIL #2
Whether or not fail safe function
is executed/ ON or OFF
ETCS has failed: ON
-
ST1
Starter signal/ ON or OFF
Cranking: ON
-
SYS GUARD JUDGE
System guard/
ON or OFF
-
ETCS service data
OPN MALFUNCTION
Open side malfunction/
ON or OFF
-
ETCS service data
THROTTLE POS
Absolute throttle position sensor/
Min.: 0%, Max.: 100%
•
•
Throttle fully closed: 10 to
24%
Throttle fully open: 64 to 96%
Read the value with intrusive
operation (active test)
THROTTL IDL POS
Whether or not throttle position
sensor is detecting idle/
ON or OFF
Idling: ON
(inspection mode)
-
THRTL REQ POS
Throttle requirement position/
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 5 V
Idling: 0.5 to 1.0 V
(Inspection mode)
-
THROTTLE POS
Throttle sensor positioning/
Min.: 0%, Max.: 100%
Idling 10 to 18%
(Inspection mode)
Calculated value based on VTA1
THROTTLE POS #2
Throttle sensor positioning #2/
Min.: 0%, Max.: 100%
-
Calculated value based on VTA2
THROTTLE POS #1
Throttle position sensor No. 1
output voltage/
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 4.98 V
-
ETCS service data
ES
ES–42
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Intelligent tester Display
Measurement Item/Range
(Display)
Normal Condition*
Diagnostic Note
THROTTLE POS #2
Throttle position sensor No.2
output voltage/
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 4.98 V
-
ETCS service data
THROTTLE POS #1
Throttle position No. 1/
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 5 V
•
•
THROTTLE POS #2
Throttle position No. 2/
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 5 V
•
•
ES
Throttle fully closed:
0.5 to 1.2 V
Throttle fully opened :
3.2 to 4.8 V
-
Throttle fully closed: 2.0 to
2.9 V
Throttle fully open: 4.6 to 5.5
V
Read the value with intrusive
operation (active test)
THRTL COMND VAL
Throttle position command value/
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 4.98 V
0.5 to 4.8 V
ETCS service data
THROTTLE SSR #1
Throttle sensor opener position
No. 1/
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 4.98 V
0.6 to 0.9 V
ETCS service data
THROTTLE SSR #2
Throttle sensor opener position
No. 2/
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 4.98 V
2.2 to 2.6 V
ETCS service data
THRTL SSR #1 AD
Throttle sensor opener position
No.1 (AD)/
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 4.98 V
0.6 to 0.9 V
ETCS service data
THROTTLE MOT
Whether or not throttle motor
control is permitted/ ON or OFF
Idling: ON
(Inspection mode)
Read the value with the power
switch ON (Do not start engine)
THROTTLE MOT
Throttle motor current
Min.: 0 A, Max.: 80 A
Idling: 0 to 3.0 A
(Inspection mode)
-
THROTTLE MOT
Throttle motor
Min.: 0%, Max.: 100%
Idling: 0.5 to 40%
(Inspection mode)
-
THROTTLE MOT
Throttle motor current
Min.: 0 A, Max.: 19.92 A
Idling: 0 to 3.0 A
-
THROTL OPN DUTY
Throttle motor opening duty ratio/
Min.: 0%, Max.: 100%
During idling: 0 to 40%
When accelerator pedal is
depressed, duty ratio is increased
THROTL CLS DUTY
Throttle motor closed duty ratio/
Min.: 0%, Max.: 100%
During idling: 0 to 40%
When accelerator pedal is
released quickly, duty ratio is
increased
THRTL MOT (OPN)
Throttle motor duty ratio (open)/
Min.: 0%, Max.: 100%
-
ETCS service data
THRTL MOT (CLS)
Throttle motor duty ratio (close)/
Min.: 0%, Max.: 100%
-
ETCS service data
O2S B1 S2
Heated oxygen sensor output
voltage for bank 1 sensor 2/
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 1.275 V
Driving: 70 km/h (44 mph)
0.1 to 0.9 V
Performing the INJ VOL or A/F
CONTROL function of the
ACTIVE TEST enables the
technician to check voltage
output of the sensor
AFS B1 S1
A/F sensor output voltage for
bank 1 sensor 1/
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 7.999 V
Idling 2.8 to 3.8 V
(Inspection mode)
Performing the INJ VOL or A/F
CONTROL function of the
ACTIVE TEST enables the
technician to check voltage
output of the sensor
TOTAL FT #1
Total fuel trim of bank 1:
Average value for fuel trim
system of bank 1/
Min.: -0.5, Max.: 0.496
Idling: -0.2 to 0.2
(Inspection mode)
-
SHORT FT #1
Short-term fuel trim of bank 1/
Min.: -100%, Max.: 99.2%
0 +- 20%
This item is the short-term fuel
compensation used to maintain
the air-fuel ratio at stoichiometric
air-fuel ratio
ES–43
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Intelligent tester Display
Measurement Item/Range
(Display)
Normal Condition*
Diagnostic Note
LONG FT #1
Long-term fuel trim of bank 1/
Min.: -100%, Max.: 99.2%
0 +- 20%
This item is the overall fuel
compensation carried out in longterm to compensate a continual
deviation of the short-term fuel
trim from the central value
FUEL SYS #1
Fuel system status (Bank1) / OL
or CL or OL DRIVE or OL FAULT
or CL FAULT
Idling after warming up: CL
(Inspection mode)
•
•
•
•
•
OL (Open Loop): Has not yet
satisfied conditions to go
closed loop
CL (Closed Loop): Using
heated oxygen sensor as
feedback for fuel control
OL DRIVE: Open loop due to
driving conditions (fuel
enrichment)
OL FAULT: Open loop due to
detected system fault
CL FAULT: Closed loop but
heated oxygen sensor, which
is used for fuel control is
malfunctioning
O2FT B1 S2
Short-term fuel trim associated
with the bank 1 sensor 2/
Min.: -100%, Max.: 99.2%
0 +- 20%
Same as SHORT FT #1
AF FT B1 S1
Short-term fuel trim associated
with the bank 1 sensor 1/
Min.: 0, Max.: 1.999
•
-
•
•
Value less than 1 (0.000 to
0.999) = Lean
Stoichiometric air-fuel ratio =
1
Value greater than 1 (1.001 to
1.999) = RICH
CAT TEMP B1S1
Catalyst temperature (Bank 1,
Sensor 1)/
Min.: -40°C, Max.: 6,513.5°C
-
-
CAT TEMP B1S2
Catalyst temperature (Bank 1,
Sensor 2)/
Min.: -40°C, Max.: 6,513.5°C
-
-
S O2S B1S2
Sub O2S Impedance B1S2:
Min.:0 Ω, Max.:21247.68 Ω
5 to 15,000 Ω
-
INI COOL TEMP
Initial engine coolant
temperature/ Min.: -40°C, Max.:
120°C
Close to ambient air temperature
Service data
INI INTAKE TEMP
Initial intake air temperature/ Min.:
-40°C, Max.: 120°C
Close to ambient air temperature
Service data
INJ VOL
Injection volume (cylinder 1)/
Min.: 0 ml, Max.: 2.048 ml
0 to 0.5 ml
Quantity of fuel injection volume
for 10 times
CTP SW
Closed Throttle Position Switch:
ON or OFF
•
•
-
ENG OIL PRES SW
Engine oil pressure switch signal/
0: OFF / 1: ON
Indicating ON while engine is
running
-
+BM
Whether or not electric throttle
control system power is inputted/
ON or OFF
Idling: ON
(inspection mode)
-
+BM VOLTAGE
+BM voltage/
Min.: 0, Max.: 19.92
Idling: 10 to 15 V
ETCS service data
BATTERY VOLTAGE
Battery voltage/
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 65.535 V
Idling: 9 to 14 V
(Inspection mode)
-
ACTUATOR POWER
Actuator power supply/
ON or OFF
Idling ON
(Inspection mode)
ETCS service data
EVAP (Purge) VSV
VSV status for EVAP control/
ON or OFF
VSV operating: ON
VSV for EVAP is controlled by the
ECM (ground side duty control)
FUEL PUMP / SPD
Fuel pump/speed status/
ON or OFF
Idling: ON
(Inspection mode)
-
ON: Throttle fully closed
OFF: Throttle open
ES
ES–44
ES
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Intelligent tester Display
Measurement Item/Range
(Display)
Normal Condition*
Diagnostic Note
VVT CTRL B1
VVT control status/
ON or OFF
-
Support for VVT active test
VACUUM PUMP
Key-off EVAP system leak
detection pump status:
ON or OFF
-
Active Test support data
EVAP VENT VAL
Key-off EVAP system vent valve
status:
ON or OFF
-
Active Test support data
FAN MOTOR
Electric fan motor:
ON or OFF
-
Support for fan motor active test
TANK BYPASS VSV
Tank bypass VSV:
ON or OFF
-
Support for tank bypass VSV
active test
TC/TE1
TC and TE1 terminal of DLC3:
ON or OFF
-
-
VVTL AIM ANGL #1
VVT aim angle (bank 1):
Min.: 0%, Max.: 100%
Idling: 0%
VVT duty signal value during
intrusive operation
VVT CHNG ANGL #1
VVT change angle:
Min.: 0°FR, Max.: 60°FR
Idling: 0 to 5 °FR
Displacement angle during
intrusive operation
VVT OCV DUTY B1
VVT OCV operation duty:
Min.: 0%, Max.:100%
Idling: 0%
Requested duty value for
intrusive operation
FC IDL
Fuel cut idle: ON or OFF
Fuel cut operation: ON
FC IDL = "ON" when throttle
valve fully closed and engine
speed is over 2,800 rpm
FC TAU
Fuel cut TAU: Fuel cut during very
light load: ON or OFF
Fuel cut operating: ON
The fuel cut is being performed
under very light load to prevent
the engine combustion from
becoming incomplete
IGNITION
Ignition counter: Min.: 0, Max.:
800
0 to 800
-
CYL #1, #2, #3, #4
Misfire ratio of the cylinder 1 to 4:
Min.: 0, Max.: 255
0%
This item is displayed in only
idling
CYL ALL
All cylinders misfire rate:
Min.: 0, Max.: 255
0 to 35
-
MISFIRE RPM
Engine RPM for first misfire
range:
Min.: 0 rpm, Max.: 6,375 rpm
Misfire 0: 0 rpm
-
MISFIRE LOAD
Engine load for first misfire range:
Min.: 0 g/rev, Max.: 3.98 g/rev
Misfire 0: 0 g/rev
-
MISFIRE MARGIN
Misfire monitoring:
MIn.: -100%, Max.: 99.22%
-100 to 99.2%
Misfire detecting margin
#CODES
#Codes:
Min.: 0, Max.: 255
-
Number of detected DTCs
CHECK MODE
Check mode: ON or OFF
Check mode ON: ON
(see page ES-32)
MISFIRE TEST
Check mode result for misfire
monitor:
COMPL or INCMPL
-
-
OXS1 TEST
Check mode result for HO2
sensor:
COMPL or INCMPL
-
-
A/F SSR TEST B1
Check mode result for air-fuel
ratio sensor:
COMPL or INCMPL
-
-
MIL
MIL status: ON or OFF
MIL ON: ON
-
MIL ON RUN DIST
MIL ON Run Distance:
Min.: 0 second,
Max.: 65,535 seconds
Distance after DTC is detected
-
ES–45
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Intelligent tester Display
Measurement Item/Range
(Display)
Normal Condition*
Diagnostic Note
MIL ON RUN TIME
Running time from MIL ON:
Min.: 0 minute,
Max.: 65,535 minutes
Equivalent to running time after
MIL was ON
-
ENG RUN TIME
Engine run time:
Min.: 0 second,
Max.: 65,535 seconds
Time after engine start
Service data
TIME DTC CLEAR
Time after DTC cleared:
Min.: 0 minute,
Max.: 65,535 minutes
Equivalent to time after DTCs
were erased
-
DIST DTC CLEAR
Distance after DTC cleared:
Min.: 0 km/h,
Max.: 65535 km/h
Equivalent to drive distance after
DTCs were erased
-
WU CYC DTC CLEAR
Warm-up cycle after DTC
cleared:
Min.: 0, Max.: 255
-
Number of warm-up cycles after
DTC is cleared
OBD CERT
OBD requirement
OBD2
-
#CARB CODES
Emission related DTCs
-
Number of emission related
DTCs
COMP MON
Comprehensive component
monitor:
NOT AVL or AVAIL
-
-
FUEL MON
Fuel system monitor:
NOT AVL or AVAIL
-
-
MISFIRE MON
Misfire monitor:
NOT AVL or AVAIL
-
-
O2S (A/FS) MON
O2S (A/FS ) heater monitor:
NOT AVL or AVAIL
-
-
O2S (A/FS) MON
O2S (A/FS ) heater monitor:
COMPL or INCMPL
-
-
EVAP MON
EVAP monitor:
NOT AVL or AVAIL
-
-
EVAP MON
EVAP monitor:
COMPL or INCMPL
-
-
CAT MON
Catalyst monitor:
NOT AVL or AVAIL
-
-
CAT MON
Catalyst monitor:
COMPL or INCMPL
-
-
CCM ENA
Comprehensive component
monitor:
UNABLE or ENABLE
-
-
CCM CMPL
Comprehensive component
monitor:
COMPL or INCMPL
-
-
FUEL ENA
Fuel system monitor:
UNABLE or ENABLE
-
-
FUEL CMPL
Fuel system monitor:
COMPL or INCMPL
-
-
MISFIRE ENA
Misfire monitor:
UNABLE or ENABLE
-
-
MISFIRE CMPL
Misfire monitor:
COMPL or INCMPL
-
-
EGR ENA
EGR Monitor:
UNABLE or ENABLE
-
-
EGR CMPL
EGR Monitor:
COMPL or INCMPL
-
-
HTR ENA
O2S (A/FS ) heater monitor:
UNABLE or ENABLE
-
-
ES
ES–46
ES
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Intelligent tester Display
Measurement Item/Range
(Display)
Normal Condition*
Diagnostic Note
HTR CMPL
O2S (A/FS ) heater monitor:
COMPL or INCMPL
-
-
O2S (A/FS) ENA
O2S (A/FS ) monitor:
UNABLE or ENABLE
-
-
O2S (A/FS) CMPL
O2S (A/FS ) monitor:
COMPL or INCMPL
-
-
ACRF ENA
A/C Monitor:
UNABLE or ENABLE
-
-
ACRF CMPL
A/C Monitor:
COMPL or INCMPL
-
-
AIR ENA
2nd Air Monitor:
UNABLE or ENABLE
-
-
AIR CMPL
2nd Air Monitor:
COMPL or INCMPL
-
-
EVAP ENA
EVAP monitor:
UNABLE or ENABLE
-
-
EVAP CMPL
EVAP monitor:
COMPL or INCMPL
-
-
HCAT ENA
Heated Catalyst Monitor:
UNABLE or ENABLE
-
-
HCAT CMPL
Heated Catalyst Monitor:
COMPL or INCMPL
-
-
CAT ENA
Catalyst monitor:
UNABLE or ENABLE
-
-
CAT CMPL
Catalyst monitor:
COMPL or INCMPL
-
-
CYLINDER NUMBER
Cylinder number:
Min.: 0, Max.: 255
-
Identifying the cylinder number
MODEL YEAR
Model year:
Min.: 0, Max.: 255
-
Identifying the model year
REQ ENG TRQ
Requested engine torque:
Min.: 0 kW, Max.: 16383.75 kW
0 to 57 kW
Flag information for hybrid vehicle
HV TRGT ENG SPD
HV target engine speed:
Min.: 0 rpm, Max.: 6375 rpm
0 to 5000 rpm
Flag information for hybrid vehicle
ACT ENGINE TRQ
Actual engine torque:
Min.: -128 Nm, Max.: 127 Nm
-128 to 127 Nm
Flag information for hybrid vehicle
EST ENGINE TRQ
Estimated engine torque:
Min.: 0 Nm, Max.: 510 Nm
0 to 120 Nm
Flag information for hybrid vehicle
ENG RUN TIME
Engine run time:
Min.: 0 second, Max.: 255
seconds
0 to 255 seconds
Flag information for hybrid vehicle
ENGINE RUN TIME
Request engine run time:
Min.: 0 second,
Max.: 25.5 seconds
0 to 25.5 seconds
Flag information for hybrid vehicle
IGNITION TIME
Judgment time for ignition of
engine:
Min.: 0 second,
Max.: 25.5 seconds
0 to 25.5 seconds
Flag information for hybrid vehicle
OUTPUT TIME
Judgment time for engine output:
Min.: 0 second,
Max.: 25.5 seconds
0 to 25.5 seconds
Flag information for hybrid vehicle
EST PORT TEMP
Estimated intake port
temperature:
Min.: -40°C, Max.: 215°C
80 to 100°C
Flag information for hybrid vehicle
FUEL LEVEL
Fuel level: EMPTY or NOT EMP
-
Flag information for hybrid vehicle
ISC LEARNING
ISC Learning:
COMPL or INCMPL
-
-
ES–47
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Intelligent tester Display
Measurement Item/Range
(Display)
Normal Condition*
Diagnostic Note
FUEL CUT
Fuel cut for engine stop request:
OFF or ON
-
Flag information for hybrid vehicle
INDPNDNT OPR
Engine independently operation:
NOT OPR or OPERATE
-
Flag information for hybrid vehicle
RACING
Rev-up operation:
NOT OPR or OPERATE
-
Flag information for hybrid vehicle
WARM UP
Request warm-up:
NOT REQ or REQUEST
-
Flag information for hybrid vehicle
INDPNDNT CNTRL
Engine independently control
operation:
NOT OPR or OPERATE
-
Flag information for hybrid vehicle
TANK WATER TEMP
CHS tank outlet temperature
sensor output:
Max: 215°C, Min: -40°C
-
•
WATER FLW VLV
Water valve position signal:
Max: 4.98 V, Min: 0 V
0.45 to 4.6 V
Voltage varies based on valve
position
ISC LEARN VAL
ISC learning value:
Max: 19.92 L/s, Min: 0 L/s
-
Flag information for hybrid vehicle
DIRECT VAL 1
Direction Val Heat Storage 3 way
valve (ctrl side):
Max: 5 V, Min: 0 V
2.5 to 4.5 V
-
DIRECT VAL 2
Direction Val Heat Storage 3 way
valve (OBD side):
Max: 5 V, Min: 0 V
2.5 to 4.5 V
-
•
MODEL CODE
Identifying model code
NHW20#
-
ENGINE TYPE
Identifying engine type
1NZFXE
-
CYLINDER NUMBER
Identifying cylinder number:
Min.: 0, Max.: 255
4
-
MODEL YEAR
Identifying model year:
Min.: 1900, Max.: 2155
200#
-
SYSTEM
Identifying engine system
HV
-
If the value is -40°C: sensor
circuit is open
If the value is 215°C: sensor
circuit is shorted
HINT:
*: If no condition is specifically stated for "ldling", it means the
transaxle position is in the N or P, the A/C switch is OFF and
all accessory switches are OFF.
2. ACTIVE TEST
HINT:
Performing ACTIVE TEST using the intelligent tester or
the OBD II scan tool allows the relay, VSV, actuator and
so on to operate without parts removal. Performing
ACTIVE TEST as a first step of troubleshooting is one
method to shorten diagnostic time.
It is possible to display DATA LIST during ACTIVE TEST.
(a) Turn the power switch ON (READY) and warm up
the engine.
(b) Turn the power switch OFF.
(c) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(e) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(f) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST.
(g) According to the display on the tester, perform items
in ACTIVE TEST.
ES
ES–48
ES
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Intelligent Tester Display
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
INJ VOL
[Test Details]
Control the injection volume
Min.: -12.5%, Max.: 24.8%
[Vehicle Condition]
Engine speed: 3,000 rpm or less
•
•
A/F CONTROL
[Test Details]
Control the injection volume
-12.5 or 24.8% (Change the injection volume
12.5 % or 25%)
[Vehicle Condition]
Engine speed: 3,000 rpm or less
The following A/F CONTROL procedure
enables the technician to check and graph the
voltage outputs of both the A/F sensor and
heated oxygen sensor
To display the graph, enter ACTIVE TEST / A/
F CONTROL / USER DATA, then select "AFS
B1S1 and O2S B1S2" or "AFS B2S1 and O2S
B2S2" by pressing "YES" button and followed
by "ENTER" button and then pressing "F4"
button
EVAP VSV (ALONE)
[Test Details]
Activate the VSV for EVAP control
ON or OFF
(See page ES-207)
TANK BYPASS VSV
[Test Details]
Activate the VSV for tank bypass
ON or OFF
(See page ES-231)
VVT CTRL B1
[Test Details]
Activate the VVT system (Bank 1)
ON or OFF
• ON: Rough idle or engine stall
• OFF: Normal engine speed
(See page ES-55)
FUEL PUMP / SPD
[Test Details]
Control the fuel pump
ON or OFF
-
TC/TE1
[Test Details]
Connect the TC and TE1
ON or OFF
-
FC IDL PROHBT
[Test Details]
Control the idle fuel cut prohibit
ON or OFF
-
COOLING FAN
[Test Details]
Control the electric cooling fan
ON or OFF
-
ETCS OPEN/CLOSE SLOW
[Test Details]
Control the ETCS opening/closing slow speed
ON or OFF
Throttle valve intrusive operation
ETCS OPEN/CLOSE FAST
[Test Details]
Control the ETCS opening/closing fast speed
ON or OFF
Throttle valve intrusive operation
FUEL CUT #1
[Test Details]
Control the cylinder #1 fuel cut
ON or OFF (Inspection mode)
Cylinder No. 1 fuel cut for power balance
FUEL CUT #2
[Test Details]
Control the cylinder #2 fuel cut
ON or OFF (Inspection mode)
Cylinder No. 2 fuel cut for power balance
FUEL CUT #3
[Test Details]
Control the cylinder #3 fuel cut
ON or OFF (Inspection mode)
Cylinder No. 3 fuel cut for power balance
FUEL CUT #4
[Test Details]
Control the cylinder #4 fuel cut
ON or OFF (Inspection mode)
Cylinder No. 4 fuel cut for power balance
VVT B1
[Test Details]
Control the VVT (bank 1)
Min.: -128%, Max.: 127%
-
WATER PUMP
[Test Details]
Activate the water pump
ON or OFF
Coolant heat storage water pump
All injectors are tested at once
Injection volume is gradually changed
between -12 and 25%
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–49
Intelligent Tester Display
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
WATER FLW VLV1
[Test Details]
Activate the water valve
ON or OFF
Unused
WATER FLW VLV2
[Test Details]
Activate the water valve
ON or OFF
Unused
WATER FLW VLV3
[Test Details]
Activate the water valve
ON or OFF
Water valve intrusive valve operation (position
when engine is in pre-heat mode)
(See page ES-304)
WATER FLW VLV4
[Test Details]
Activate the water valve
ON or OFF
Water valve intrusive valve operation (position
when hot coolant recovering)
(See page ES-304)
WATER FLW VLV5
[Test Details]
Activate the water valve
ON or OFF
Water valve intrusive valve operation (position
when engine is in normal operation)
(See page ES-304)
VACUUM PUMP
[Test Details]
Activate the leak detection pump
ON or OFF
-
VENT VALVE
[Test Details]
Activate the vent valve
ON or OFF
-
ES
ES–50
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
HINT:
Parameters listed in the chart may be different than your
readings depending on the type of instrument and other
factors.
If any DTCs are displayed during a check mode DTC check,
check the circuit for the DTCs listed in the table below. For
details of each DTC, refer to the page indicated.
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
MIL
Memory
See page
P0010
Camshaft Position
"A" Actuator Circuit
(Bank 1)
- Open or short in oil
control valve circuit
- Oil control valve
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-55
P0011
Camshaft Position
"A" - Timing OverAdvanced or System
Performance (Bank
1)
- Valve timing
- Oil control valve
- Camshaft timing
gear assembly
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-59
P0012
Camshaft Position
"A" - Timing OverRetarded (Bank 1)
- Same as DTC
P0011
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-59
P0016
Crankshaft Position Camshaft Position
Correlation (Bank 1
Sensor A)
- Mechanical system
(timing chain has
jumped a tooth, chain
stretched)
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-63
P0031
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor
Heater Control Circuit
Low (Bank 1 Sensor
1)
- Open or short in
heater circuit of A/F
sensor
- A/F sensor heater
- EFI M relay
(Integration relay)
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-65
P0032
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor
Heater Control Circuit
High (Bank 1 Sensor
1)
- Short in heater
circuit of A/F sensor
- A/F sensor heater
- EFI M relay
(Integration relay)
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-65
P0037
Oxygen Sensor
Heater Control Circuit
Low (Bank 1 Sensor
2)
- Open or short in
heater circuit of the
heated oxygen
sensor
- Heated oxygen
sensor heater
- EFI M relay
(integration relay)
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-70
P0038
Oxygen Sensor
Heater Control Circuit
High (Bank 1 Sensor
2)
- Short in heater
circuit of the heated
oxygen sensor
- Heated oxygen
sensor heater
- EFI M relay
(integration relay)
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-70
P0100
Mass or Volume Air
Flow Circuit
- Open or short in
mass air flow meter
circuit
- Mass air flow meter
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-76
ES
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
MIL
Memory
ES–51
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
P0101
Mass Air Flow Circuit
Range / Performance
Problem
- Mass air flow meter
Come on
DTC Stored
See page
ES-83
P0102
Mass or Volume Air
Flow Circuit Low
Input
- Open in mass air
flow meter circuit
- Mass air flow meter
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-76
P0103
Mass or Volume Air
Flow Circuit High
Input
- Short in mass air
flow meter circuit
- Mass air flow meter
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-76
P0110
Intake Air
Temperature Circuit
- Open or short in
intake air
temperature sensor
circuit
- Intake air
temperature sensor
(built in mass air flow
meter)
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-85
ES
P0112
Intake Air
Temperature Circuit
Low Input
- Short in intake air
temperature sensor
circuit
- Intake air
temperature sensor
(built in mass air flow
meter)
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-85
P0113
Intake Air
Temperature Circuit
High Input
- Open in intake air
temperature sensor
circuit
- Intake air
temperature sensor
(built in mass air flow
meter)
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-85
P0115
Engine Coolant
Temperature Circuit
- Open or short in
engine coolant
temperature sensor
circuit
- Engine coolant
temperature sensor
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-91
P0116
Engine Coolant
Temperature Circuit
Range / Performance
Problem
- Engine coolant
temperature sensor
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-97
P0117
Engine Coolant
Temperature Circuit
Low Input
- Short in engine
coolant temperature
sensor circuit
- Engine coolant
temperature sensor
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-91
P0118
Engine Coolant
Temperature Circuit
High Input
- Open in engine
coolant temperature
sensor circuit
- Engine coolant
temperature sensor
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-91
ES–52
DTC No.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Detection Item
Trouble Area
MIL
Memory
See page
P0120
Throttle Pedal
Position Sensor /
Switch "A" Circuit
Malfunction
- Open or short in
throttle position
sensor circuit
- Throttle position
sensor (built in
throttle body)
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-100
P0121
Throttle / Pedal
Position Sensor /
Switch "A" Circuit
Range / Performance
Problem
- Throttle position
sensor (built in
throttle body)
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-107
P0122
Throttle / Pedal
Position Sensor /
Switch "A" Circuit
Low Input
- Throttle position
sensor
- Open in VTA1 circuit
- Open in VC circuit
(when the VC circuit
is open, DTCs P0222
and P2135 are also
output
simultaneously)
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-100
P0123
Throttle / Pedal
Position Sensor /
Switch "A" Circuit
High Input
- Throttle position
sensor (built in
throttle body)
- Open in VTA circuit
- Open in E2 circuit
- VC and VTA circuits
are short-circuited
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-100
P0125
Insufficient Coolant
Temperature for
Closed Loop Fuel
Control
- Cooling system
- Engine coolant
temperature sensor
- Thermostat
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-109
P0128
Coolant Thermostat
(Coolant
Temperature Below
Thermostat
Regulating
Temperature)
- Thermostat
- Cooling system
- Engine coolant
temperature sensor
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-112
P0136
Oxygen Sensor
Circuit Malfunction
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
- Heated oxygen
sensor (bank 1
sensor 2) circuit
- Heated oxygen
sensor (bank 1
sensor 2)
- Heated oxygen
sensor heater (bank
1 sensor 2)
- A/F sensor (bank 1
sensor 1)
- A/F sensor heater
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-115
P0137
Oxygen Sensor
Circuit Low Voltage
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
- Heated oxygen
sensor (bank 1
sensor 2) circuit
- Heated oxygen
sensor (bank 1
sensor 2)
- Heated oxygen
sensor heater (bank
1 sensor 2)
- A/F sensor (bank 1
sensor 1)
- A/F sensor heater
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-115
ES
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
MIL
Memory
ES–53
See page
P0138
Oxygen Sensor
Circuit High Voltage
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
- Heated oxygen
sensor (bank 1
sensor 2) circuit
- Heated oxygen
sensor (bank 1
sensor 2)
- Heated oxygen
sensor heater (bank
1 sensor 2)
- A/F sensor (bank 1
sensor 1)
- A/F sensor heater
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-115
P0171
System Too Lean
(Fuel Trim)
- Air induction system
- Injector has
blockage
- Mass air flow meter
- Engine coolant
temperature sensor
- Fuel pressure
- Gas leakage in
exhaust system
- Open or short in A/F
sensor (bank 1
sensor 1) circuit
- A/F sensor (bank 1
sensor 1)
- A/F sensor heater
(bank 1 sensor 1)
- EFI M relay
(integration relay)
- PCV valve and hose
- PCV hose
connection
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-128
ES
P0172
System Too Rich
(Bank 1)
- Injector has leakage
or blockage
- Mass air flow meter
- Engine coolant
temperature sensor
- Ignition system
- Fuel pressure
- Gas leakage in
exhaust system
- Open or short in A/F
sensor (bank 1
sensor 1) circuit
- A/F sensor (bank 1
sensor 1)
- A/F sensor heater
(bank 1 sensor 1)
- EFI M relay
(integration relay)
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-128
P0220
Throttle / Pedal
Position Sensor /
Switch "B" Circuit
- Open or short in
throttle position
sensor circuit
- Throttle position
sensor
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-100
ES–54
DTC No.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Detection Item
Trouble Area
MIL
Memory
See page
P0222
Throttle / Pedal
Position Sensor /
Switch "B" Circuit
Low Input
- Throttle position
sensor
- Open in VTA2 circuit
- Open in VC circuit
(when the VC circuit
is open, DTCs P0122
and P2135 are also
output
simultaneously)
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-100
P0223
Throttle / Pedal
Position Sensor /
Switch "B" Circuit
High Input
- Throttle position
sensor
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-100
P0300
Random / Multiple
Cylinder Misfire
Detected
- Open or short in
engine wire harness
- Connector
connection
- Vacuum hose
connection
- Ignition system
- Injector
- Fuel pressure
- Mass air flow meter
- Engine coolant
temperature sensor
- Compression
pressure
- Valve clearance
- Valve timing
- PCV hose
connection
- PCV hose
- ECM
Comes on/Blink
DTC Stored
ES-141
P0301
Cylinder 1 Misfire
Detected
- Same as DTC
P0300
Comes on/Blink
DTC Stored
ES-141
P0302
Cylinder 2 Misfire
Detected
- Same as DTC
P0300
Comes on/Blink
DTC Stored
ES-141
P0303
Cylinder 3 Misfire
Detected
- Same as DTC
P0300
Comes on/Blink
DTC Stored
ES-141
P0304
Cylinder 4 Misfire
Detected
- Same as DTC
P0300
Comes on/Blink
DTC Stored
ES-141
P0325
Knock Sensor 1
Circuit
- Open or short in
knock sensor circuit
- Knock sensor
(looseness)
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-154
P0327
Knock Sensor 1
Circuit Low Input
(Bank 1 or Single
Sensor)
- Short in knock
sensor circuit
- Knock sensor
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-154
P0328
Knock Sensor 1
Circuit High Input
(Bank 1 or Single
Sensor)
- Open in knock
sensor circuit
- Knock sensor
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-154
P0335
Crankshaft Position
Sensor "A" Circuit
- Open or short in
crankshaft position
sensor circuit
- Crankshaft position
sensor
- Signal plate
(crankshaft)
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-159
ES
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
MIL
Memory
ES–55
See page
P0340
Camshaft Position
Sensor Circuit
Malfunction
- Open or short in
camshaft position
sensor circuit
- Camshaft position
sensor
- Camshaft timing
pulley
- Timing chain has
jumped a tooth
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-163
P0341
Camshaft Position
Sensor "A" Circuit
Range / Performance
(Bank 1 or Single
Sensor)
- Same as DTC
P0340
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-163
P0351
Ignition Coil "A"
Primary / Secondary
Circuit
- Ignition system
- Open or short in IGF
or IGT1 circuit
between ignition coil
with igniter and ECM
- No.1 ignition coil
with igniter
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-167
P0352
Ignition Coil "B"
Primary / Secondary
Circuit
- Ignition system
- Open or short in IGF
or IGT2 circuit
between ignition coil
with igniter and ECM
- No.2 ignition coil
with igniter
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-167
P0353
Ignition Coil "C"
Primary / Secondary
Circuit
- Ignition system
- Open or short in IGF
or IGT3 circuit
between ignition coil
with igniter and ECM
- No.3 ignition coil
with igniter
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-167
P0354
Ignition Coil "D"
Primary / Secondary
Circuit
- Ignition system
- Open or short in IGF
or IGT4 circuit
between ignition coil
with igniter and ECM
- No.4 ignition coil
with igniter
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-167
P0420
Catalyst System
Efficiency Below
Threshold (Bank 1)
- Gas leakage in
exhaust system
- A/F sensor (bank 1
sensor 1)
- Heated oxygen
sensor (bank 1
sensor 2)
- Three-way catalytic
converter (exhaust
manifold)
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-177
ES
ES–56
ES
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
P043E
Evaporative Emission
System Reference
Orifice Clog Up
- Canister pump
module (Reference
orifice, leak detection
pump, vent valve)
- Connector/wire
harness (Canister
pump module - ECM)
- EVAP system hose
(pipe from air inlet
port to canister pump
module, canister
filter, fuel tank vent
hose)
- ECM
Come on
MIL
DTC Stored
Memory
See page
ES-184
P043F
Evaporative Emission
System Reference
Orifice High Flow
- Same as DTC
P043E
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-184
P0441
Evaporative Emission
Control System
Incorrect Purge Flow
- Purge VSV
- Connector/wire
harness (Purge VSV
- ECM)
- Canister pump
module
- Leakage from EVAP
system
- Leakage from EVAP
line (Purge VSV Intake manifold)
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-207
P0446
Evaporative Emission
Control System Vent
Control Circuit
- Pressure swithing
valve
- EVAP line (Pressure
switching valve - Fuel
tank)
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-231
P0450
Evaporative Emission
Control System
Pressure Sensor
Malfunction
- Canister pump
module
- EVAP system hose
(pipe from air inlet
port to canister pump
module, canister
filter, fuel tank vent
hose)
- Connector/wire
harness (Canister
pump module - ECM)
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-245
P0451
Evaporative Emission
Control System
Pressure Sensor
Range / Performance
- Canister pump
module
- EVAP system hose
(pipe from air inlet
port to canister pump
module, canister
filter, fuel tank vent
hose)
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-245
P0452
Evaporative Emission
Control System
Pressure Sensor /
Switch Low Input
- Same as DTC
P0450
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-245
P0453
Evaporative Emission
Control System
Pressure Sensor /
Switch High Input
- Same as DTC
P0450
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-245
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
MIL
Memory
ES–57
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
P0455
Evaporative Emission
Control System Leak
Detected (Gross
Leak)
- Fuel cap (loose)
- Leakage from EVAP
line (Canister - Fuel
tank)
- Leakage from EVAP
line (Purge VSV Canister)
- Canister pump
module
- Leakage from fuel
tank
- Leakage from
canister
Come on
DTC Stored
See page
ES-259
P0456
Evaporative Emission
Control System Leak
Detected (Very Small
Leak)
- Same as DTC
P0455
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-259
P0505
Idle Control System
Malfunction
- Open or short in idle
speed control (ISC)
valve circuit
- Idle speed control
(ISC) valve has stuck
closed
- ECM
- Air induction system
- PCV valve and hose
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-282
P0560
System Voltage
- Open in back up
power source circuit
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-285
P0604
Internal Control
Module Random
Access Memory
(RAM) Error
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-289
P0606
ECM / PCM
Processor
- ECM
Come on
-
ES-289
P0607
Control Module
Performance
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-289
P0657
Actuator Supply
Voltage Circuit /
Open
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-289
P1115
Coolant Temperature
Sensor Circuit for
Coolant Heat Storage
System
- Coolant heat
storage tank outlet
temperature sensor
- Open or short in
temperature sensor
circuit
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-291
P1116
Coolant Temperature
Sensor Circuit Stack
for Coolant Heat
Storage
- Coolant heat
storage tank outlet
temperature sensor
- Cooling system
(clogging)
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-296
P1117
Coolant Temperature
Sensor Circuit Low
for Coolant Heat
Storage
- Coolant heat
storage tank outlet
temperature sensor
- Short in
temperature sensor
circuit
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-291
ES
ES–58
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC No.
Detection Item
P1118
Coolant Temperature
Sensor Circuit High
for Coolant Heat
Storage
- Coolant heat
storage tank outlet
temperature sensor
- Open in
temperature sensor
circuit
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-291
P1120
Coolant Flow Control
Valve Position
Sensor Circuit
- Open or short in
water valve position
sensor circuit
- Water valve (coolant
flow control valve)
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-298
P1121
Coolant Flow Control
Valve Position
Sensor Circuit Stuck
- Water valve (coolant
flow control valve)
- Cooling system
(clogging)
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-304
P1122
Coolant Flow Control
Valve Position
Sensor Circuit Low
- Water valve (coolant
flow control valve)
- Short in WBAD
(valve position signal)
circuit
- Open in VC circuit
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-298
P1123
Coolant Flow Control
Valve Position
Sensor Circuit High
- Water valve (coolant
flow control valve)
- Open in E2 circuit
- VC and WBAD
circuits are shortcircuited
- Open in WBAD
circuit
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-298
P1150
Coolant Path Clog of
Coolant Heat Storage
System
- Coolant heat
storage tank outlet
temperature sensor
- Water valve (coolant
flow control valve)
- Cooling system
(clogging)
- Heat storage tank
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-308
P1151
Coolant Heat Storage
Tank
- Heat storage tank
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-312
P1450
Fuel Tank Pressure
Sensor
- Fuel tank pressure
sensor
- Connector/wire
harness (Fuel tank
pressure sensor ECM)
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-315
P1451
Fuel Tank Pressure
Sensor Range/
Performance
- Fuel tank pressure
sensor
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-315
P1452
Fuel Tank Pressure
Sensor Low Input
- Fuel tank pressure
sensor
- Connector/wire
harness (Fuel tank
pressure sensor ECM)
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-315
ES
Trouble Area
MIL
Memory
See page
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
MIL
Memory
ES–59
See page
P1453
Fuel Tank Pressure
Sensor High Input
- Fuel tank pressure
sensor
- Connector/wire
harness (Fuel tank
pressure sensor ECM)
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-315
P1455
Vapor Reducing Fuel
Tank System
Malfunction
- Fuel Tank
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-327
P2102
Throttle Actuator
Control Motor Circuit
Low
- Open or short in
throttle control motor
circuit
- Throttle control
motor
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-329
ES
P2103
Throttle Actuator
Control Motor Circuit
High
- Short in throttle
control motor circuit
- Throttle control
motor
- Throttle valve
- Throttle body
assembly
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-329
P2111
Throttle Actuator
Control System Stuck Open
- Throttle control
motor circuit
- Throttle control
motor
- Throttle body
- Throttle valve
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-333
P2112
Throttle Actuator
Control System Stuck Closed
- Throttle control
motor circuit
- Throttle control
motor
- Throttle body
- Throttle valve
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-333
P2118
Throttle Actuator
Control Motor Current
Range / Performance
- Open in ETCS
power source circuit
- ETCS fuse
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-336
P2119
Throttle Actuator
Control Throttle Body
Range / Performance
- Electric throttle
control system
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-341
P2135
Throttle / Pedal
Position Sensor /
Switch "A" / "B"
Voltage Correlation
- VTA and VTA2
circuits are shortcircuited
- Open in VC circuit
- Throttle position
sensor
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-100
P2195
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor
Signal Stuck Lean
(Bank 1 Sensor 1)
- Open or short in A/F
sensor (bank 1
sensor 1) circuit
- A/F sensor (bank 1
sensor 1)
- A/F sensor heater
- Integration relay
- A/F sensor heater
and relay circuit
- Air induction system
- Fuel pressure
- Injector
- PCV hose
connection
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-344
ES–60
ES
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC No.
Detection Item
P2196
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor
Signal Stuck Rich
(Bank 1 Sensor 1)
- Same as DTC
P2195
Trouble Area
Come on
MIL
DTC Stored
Memory
See page
ES-344
P2238
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor
Pumping Current
Circuit Low (Bank 1
Sensor 1)
- Open or short in A/F
sensor (bank 1
sensor 1)
- A/F sensor (bank 1
sensor 1)
- A/F sensor heater
- EFI M relay
(integration relay)
- A/F sensor heater
and relay circuit
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-357
P2239
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor
Pumping Current
Circuit High (Bank 1
Sensor 1)
- Same as DTC
P2238
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-357
P2252
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor
Reference Ground
Circuit Low (Bank 1
Sensor 1)
- Same as DTC
P2238
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-357
P2253
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor
Reference Ground
Circuit High (Bank 1
Sensor 1)
- Same as DTC
P2238
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-357
P2401
Evaporative Emission
Leak Detection Pump
Stuck OFF
- Same as DTC
P043E
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-184
P2402
Evaporative Emission
Leak Detection Pump
Stuck ON
- Same as DTC
P043E
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-184
P2419
Evaporative Emission
Pressure Switching
Valve Stuck ON
- Same as DTC
P043E
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-184
P2420
Evaporative Emission
Pressure Switching
Valve Stuck OFF
- Pump module (0.02
inch orifice, vacuum
pump, vent valve)
- Connector / wire
harness (Pump
module - ECM)
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-363
P2601
Coolant Pump
Control Circuit Range
/ Performance
- CHS water pump
- CHS water pump
relay
- Open or short in
CHS water pump
circuit
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-384
P2610
ECM / PCM Internal
Engine Off Timer
Performance
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-390
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
MIL
Memory
ES–61
See page
P2A00
A/F Sensor Circuit
Slow Response
(Bank 1 Sensor 1)
- Open or short in A/F
sensor (bank 1
sensor 1) circuit
- A/F sensor (bank 1
sensor 1)
- A/F sensor heater
- EFI M relay
(integration relay)
- A/F sensor heater
and relay circuit
- Air induction system
- Fuel pressure
- Injector
- PCV hose
connection
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-392
P3190
Poor Engine Power
- Air induction system
- Throttle body
- Fuel pressure
- Engine
- Air flow meter
- Lack of fuel
- Engine coolant
temperature sensor
- Crankshaft position
sensor
- Camshaft position
sensor
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-403
P3191
Engine dose not Start
- Air induction system
- Throttle body
- Fuel pressure
- Engine
- Air flow meter
- Lack of fuel
- Engine coolant
temperature sensor
- Crankshaft position
sensor
- Camshaft position
sensor
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-403
P3193
Fuel Run Out
- Lack of fuel
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-403
U0293
Lost Communication
with HV ECU
- Wire harness
- HV ECU
- ECM
Come on
DTC Stored
ES-410
ES
ES–62
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0010
Camshaft Position "A" Actuator Circuit (Bank
1)
DESCRIPTION
ES
The Variable Valve Timing (VVT) system includes the ECM, the Oil Control Valve (OCV) and the VVT
controller. The ECM sends a target "duty-cycle" control signal to the OCV. This control signal, applied to
the OCV, regulates the oil pressure supplied to the VVT controller. Camshaft timing control is performed
based on engine operation condition such as intake air volume, throttle position and engine coolant
temperature.
The ECM controls the OCV based on the signals from several sensors. The VVT controller regulates the
intake camshaft angle using oil pressure through the OCV. As result, the relative position between the
camshaft and the crankshaft is optimized, the engine torque and fuel economy improve, and exhaust
emissions decrease. The ECM detects the actual valve timing using signals from the camshaft position
sensor and the crankshaft position sensor. The ECM performs feedback control and verifies target valve
timing.
ECM
Crankshaft Position Sensor
MAF Meter
Duty Control
Target Valve Timing
Throttle Position Sensor
Feedback
Camshaft Timing
Oil Control Valve
(OCV)
ECT Sensor
Correction
Vehicle Speed Signal
Actual Valve Timing
Camshaft Position Sensor
A103843E02
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0010
Open or short in oil control valve circuit
•
•
•
Open or short in oil control valve circuit
Oil control valve
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
After the ECM sends the "target" duty-cycle signal to the OCV, the ECM monitors the OCV current to
establish an "actual" duty-cycle. The ECM detects malfunction and sets a DTC when the actual duty-cycle
ratio varies from the target duty-cycle ratio.
ES–63
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0010: VVT oil control valve range check
Required sensors/components
OCV
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
1 second
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
None
Battery voltage
11 to 13 V
Target duty ratio
Less than 70%
Current cut status
Not cut
ES
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Output signal duty for OCV
Output duty is 3% or less despite the ECM supplying the current to the
OCV or Output duty is 100%
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Output signal duty for OCV
More than 3% and less than 100%
WIRING DIAGRAM
Camshaft Timing
Oil Control Valve
ECM
OCV+
OCV-
A112564E03
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine condition when
malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was
running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or rich, and other data
from the time the malfunction occurred.
ES–64
1
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (OPERATE OCV)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Put the engine in inspection mode (see page ES-1).
Start the engine and warm it up.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / VVT CTRL B1.
(g) Using the intelligent tester, operate the OCV and check
the engine speed.
OK
ES
Tester Operation
Specified Condition
OCV is OFF
Normal engine speed
OCV is ON
Rough idle or engine stall
NOTICE:
Do not drive the vehicle without deactivating inspection
mode, otherwise damaging the transaxle may result.
OK
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
NG
2
INSPECT CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY (OCV)
OK:
OCV has no contamination and moves smoothly.
NG
REPLACE CAMSHAFT TIMING CONTROL
VALVE ASSEMBLY
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE (OCV) ECM)
(a) Disconnect the C2 camshaft timing oil control valve
connector.
Wire Harness Side
Camshaft
Timing Oil
Control Valve
Connector
C2
Front View
A054386E10
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(b) Disconnect the E4 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E4
Tester Connection
OCV+
ES–65
OCVECM Connector
Specified Condition
C2-1 - E4-15 (OCV+)
Below 1 Ω
C2-2 - E4-14 (OCV-)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
A065743E67
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
C2-1 or E4-15 (OCV+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
C2-2 or E4-14 (OCV-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the camshaft timing oil control valve
connector.
(e) Reconnect the ECM connector.
NG
OK
REPLACE ECM
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
ES
ES–66
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0011
Camshaft Position "A" - Timing Over-Advanced
or System Performance (Bank 1)
DTC
P0012
Camshaft Position "A" - Timing Over-Retarded
(Bank 1)
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0010 (see page ES-55).
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0011
Valve timing is not adjusted in valve timing
advance range
(1 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
Camshaft timing gear assembly
Oil control valve
Valve timing
P0012
Valve timing is not adjusted in valve timing
retard range
(2 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
Camshaft timing gear assembly
Oil control valve
Valve timing
ES
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
To monitor the VVT components, the ECM (PCM) measures the valve timing that is calculated by the
camshaft position and crankshaft position. The valve timing is usually adjusted in accordance with the
driving condition. If the valve timing variation is less than the malfunction criterion, the ECM illuminates
the MIL and set a DTC. P0011 is set when the valve timing is in the valve timing advance range. P0012 is
set when the valve timing is in valve timing retard range.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0011: VVT system advance (bank)
P0012: VVT system retard (bank 1)
Required sensors/components
Main sensors:
Camshaft timing gear assembly
Oil control valve
Related sensors:
Camshaft position sensor
Engine coolant temperature sensor
Crankshaft position sensor
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
10 seconds
MIL operation
P0011: Immediately
P0012: 2 driving cycles
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
P0100 - P0103 (MAF meter)
P0115 - P0118 (ECT sensor)
P0125 (Insufficient ECT for closed loop)
P0335 (CKP sensor)
P0340, P0341 (CMP sensor)
P0351-P0354 (Igniter)
Battery voltage
11 V or more
Engine speed
900 to 5,000 rpm
Engine coolant temperature
75 to 100°C(167 to 212°F)
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–67
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Following conditions are met:
1 and 2
1. Deviation of valve timing
(Target valve timing - Actual valve timing)
More than 5°CA
2. Response of valve timing
No change
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0010 (see page ES-56).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine condition when
malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was
running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or rich, and other data
from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
CHECK VALVE TIMING (CHECK FOR LOOSE AND A JUMPED TOOTH OF TIMING CHAIN)
OK:
The match marks of crankshaft pulley and camshaft
pulley are aligning.
NG
ADJUST VALVE TIMING
OK
2
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (OPERATE OCV)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Put the engine in inspection mode (see page ES-1).
Start the engine and warm it up.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / VVT CTRL B1.
(g) Using the intelligent tester, operate the OCV and check
the engine speed.
OK
Tester Operation
Specified Condition
OCV is OFF
Normal engine speed
OCV is ON
Rough idle or engine stall
NOTICE:
Do not drive the vehicle without deactivating
inspection mode, otherwise damaging the transaxle
may result.
NG
OK
Go to step 5
ES
ES–68
3
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK IF DTC OUTPUT RECURS
(a) Clear the DTCs (see page ES-29).
(b) Start the HV main system and warm the engine up.
(c) Drive the vehicle with the shift position in B at vehicle
speed of more than 44 mph (70 km/h) approximately for
10 minutes or more.
(d) Read output DTCs using the intelligent tester.
OK:
No DTC output.
HINT:
*: DTC P0011 or P0012 is output when a foreign object in
engine oil is caught in some part of the system.
These codes will stay registered even if the system returns to
normal after a short time. Foreign objects are filtered out by
the oil filter.
ES
OK
VVT SYSTEM OK*
NG
4
INSPECT OIL CONTROL VALVE FILTER
Bolt
Oil Control Valve Filter
A091578E01
(a) Remove the air cleaner inlet, bolt and oil control valve
filter.
(b) Check for blockages in the oil control valve filter.
(c) Reinstall the filter, bolt and air cleaner inlet.
NOTICE:
If necessary, clean the filter.
OK:
The filter has not clogged.
NG
REPLACE OIL CONTROL VALVE FILTER
OK
5
INSPECT CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY (OCV)
OK:
OCV has no contamination and moves smoothly.
NG
REPLACE CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL
CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY
OK
6
NEXT
REPLACE CAMSHAFT TIMING GEAR ASSEMBLY
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
7
ES–69
CHECK IF DTC OUTPUT RECURS
(a) Clear the DTCs (see page ES-29).
(b) Start the HV system, and warm the engine up.
(c) Drive the vehicle with the shift position in B at vehicle
speed of more than 70 km/h (44 mph) approximately for
10 minutes or more.
(d) Read output DTCs using the intelligent tester.
OK:
No DTC output.
NG
OK
END
REPLACE ECM
ES
ES–70
DTC
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
P0016
Crankshaft Position - Camshaft Position Correlation (Bank 1 Sensor A)
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0335 (see page ES-159).
ES
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0016
Deviation in crankshaft position sensor signal
and VVT sensor signal
(2 trip detection logic)
•
•
Mechanical system (timing chain has
jumped a tooth, chain stretched)
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM optimizes the valve timing using the Variable Valve Timing (VVT) system to control the intake
valve camshaft. The VVT system includes the ECM, the Oil Control Valve (OCV) and the VVT controller.
The ECM sends a target "duty-cycle" control signal to the OCV. This control signal, applied to the OCV,
regulates the oil pressure supplied to the VVT controller. The VVT controller can advance or retard the
intake valve camshaft. The ECM calibrates the valve timing of the VVT system by setting the camshaft to
the maximum retard angle when the engine speed is idling. The ECM closes the OCV to retard the cam.
The ECM stores this valve as "VVT learned value" (when the difference between the target valve timing
and the actual valve timing is 5 degrees or less, the ECM stores this in its memory).
If the learned value meets both of the following conditions ("a" and "b"), the ECM interprets this as a
defect in the VVT system and sets a DTC.
(a) VVT learning value is less than 30°CA (CA: Crankshaft Angle), or more than 46°CA.
(b) Above condition continues for more than 18 second.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0016:
Deviation in crankshaft position sensor signal and VVT sensor signal
Required sensors/components
Crankshaft position sensor, camshaft position sensor
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
60 seconds
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
P0011 (VVT System 1 - Advance)
P0012 (VVT System 1 - Retard)
P0115 - P0118 (ECT sensor)
Engine speed
900 to 5,000 rpm
Valve timing
Maximum valve timing retard
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Either of the following conditions is met:
(a) or (b)
(a) VVT learned value
Less than 30°CA
(b) VVT learned value
More than 46°CA
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0335 (see page ES-160).
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–71
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine condition when
malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was
running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or rich, and other data
from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
CHECK VALVE TIMING (CHECK FOR LOOSE AND A JUMPED TOOTH OF TIMING CHAIN)
OK:
The match marks of crankshaft pulley and camshaft
pulley are aligning.
NG
OK
REPLACE ECM
ADJUST VALVE TIMING (REPAIR OR
REPLACE TIMING CHAIN)
ES
ES–72
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0031
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Heater Control Circuit
Low (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
DTC
P0032
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Heater Control Circuit
High (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
DESCRIPTION
ES
Refer to DTC P2195 (see page ES-344).
HINT:
• Although each DTC title says "oxygen sensor," these DTCs are related to the air-fuel ratio sensor (A/F
sensor).
• The ECM provides a pulse width modulated control circuit to adjust current through the heater. The A/F
sensor heater circuit uses a relay on the +B side of the circuit.
Reference (Bank 1 Sensor 1 System Diagram)
From
Battery
EFI
EFI M
ECM
A/F Sensor
+B
HT
AF-
AF+
HA1A
Heater
A1A+
Sensor
A1A-
Duty
Control
MREL
B062793E17
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0031
Heater current is less than 0.8 A when the
heater operates
(1 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
Open or short in heater circuit of A/F
sensor
A/F sensor heater
EFI M relay (integration relay)
ECM
Heater current exceeds 10 A when the heater
operates
(1 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
Short in heater circuit of A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
EFI M relay (integration relay)
ECM
P0032
HINT:
• Sensor 1 refers to the sensor mounted before the TWC and is located near the engine assembly.
• Sensor 2 refers to the sensor mounted after the TWC and is located far from the engine assembly.
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM uses the Air-Fuel Ratio (A/F) sensor information to regulate the air-fuel ratio close to the
stoichiometric ratio. This maximizes the catalytic converter's ability to purify exhaust gases. The sensor
detects oxygen levels in the exhaust gas and sends this signal to the ECM.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–73
The inner surface of the sensor element is exposed to outside air. The outer surface of the sensor
element is exposed to the exhaust gas. The sensor element is made of platinum coated zirconia and
includes an integrated heating element. The zirconia element generates a small voltage when there is a
large difference between the oxygen concentrations of the exhaust and the outside air. The platinum
coating amplifies the voltage generation. When heated, the sensor becomes very efficient. If the
temperature of the exhaust is low, the sensor will not generate useful voltage signals without
supplemental heating. The ECM regulates the supplemental heating using a duty-cycle approach to
regulate the average current in the heater element. If the heater current is out of the normal range, the
sensor output signals will be inaccurate and the ECM can not regulate the air-fuel ratio properly.
When the heater current is out of the normal operating range, the ECM interprets this as malfunction of
the sensor and sensor circuit and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0031: A/F sensor heater current (low current)
P0032: A/F sensor heater current (high current)
Required sensors/components
A/F sensor, ECM
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
10 seconds
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
P0300 - P0304 (Misfire)
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
Heater duty ratio-cycle
P0031: 50% or more
P0032: More than 0%
Time after engine start
10 seconds or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P0031:
A/F sensor heater current
Less than 0.8 A
P0031:
A/F sensor heater current
More than 10 A
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
A/F sensor heater current
1.8 to 3.4 A (at 20°C [68°F])
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P2195 (see page ES-347).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• When DTC P0032 is detected, proceed to step 4 if the heater resistance is in normal range.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine condition
when malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the
vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or
rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
ES
ES–74
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
1
INSPECT AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR (HEATER RESISTANCE)
(a) Disconnect the A5 A/F sensor connector.
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the A/F
sensor connector.
Standard resistance
Component Side
A/F Sensor Connector
HT
+B
A5
AF-
ES
Specified Condition
1 (HT) - 2 (+B)
1.8 to 3.4 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
(c) Reconnect the A/F sensor connector.
AF+
Front View
Tester Connection
A085152E45
NG
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
OK
2
INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY (EFI M RELAY)
Integration Relay
Connector
IGCT
HORN
AM2
IG2
EFI
EFI M
Relay Detail
6
7
8
1
Specified Condition
3K-1 - 3I-8
10 kΩ or higher
3K-1 - 3I-8
Below 1 Ω
(Apply battery voltage to terminals
3I-6 and 3I-7)
NG
3I
3I
3I
3K
A082812E01
OK
Tester Connection
(c) Reinstall the integration relay.
3I
3I
3I
3K
8
7
6
1
(a) Remove the integration relay from the engine room relay
block.
(b) Inspect the EFI M relay.
Standard resistance
REPLACE INTEGRATION RELAY
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
3
ES–75
CHECK ECM (HA1A VOLTAGE)
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Measure the voltage between the applicable terminals of
the E5 ECM connector.
Standard voltage
E5
HA1A (+)
E1 (-)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E5-7 (HA1A) - E5-28 (E1)
9 to 14 V
OK
ECM Connector
REPLACE ECM
ES
A119979E45
NG
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (A/F SENSOR - ECM, A/F SENSOR - EFI M RELAY)
(a) Check the harness and the connectors between the
ECM and the A/F sensor connectors.
(1) Disconnect the A5 A/F sensor connector.
Wire Harness Side
A/F Sensor Connector
HT
+B
A5
Front View
A085153E04
(2) Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
(3) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E5
HA1A
ECM Connector
A081695E08
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A5-1 (HT) - E5-7 (HA1A)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A5-1 (HT) or E5-7 (HA1A) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
A5-1 (HT) - A5-2 (+B)
10 kΩ or higher
(4) Reconnect the A/F sensor connector.
(5) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(b) Check the harness and connectors between the A/F
sensor connector and the EFI M relay.
(1) Disconnect the A5 A/F sensor connector.
ES–76
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(2) Remove the integration relay from the engine room
relay block.
(3) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
8 3I
Engine Room Relay Block
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A5-2 (+B) - 3I-8 (EFI M relay)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
A082810E01
ES
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A5-2 (+B) or 3I-8 (EFI M relay) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(4) Reconnect the A/F sensor connector.
(5) Reinstall the integration relay.
NG
OK
REPLACE ECM
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
ES–77
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0037
Oxygen Sensor Heater Control Circuit Low
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
DTC
P0038
Oxygen Sensor Heater Control Circuit High
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0136 (see page ES-115).
HINT:
The ECM provides a pulse width modulated control circuit to adjust current through the heater. The
heated oxygen sensor heater circuit uses a relay on the +B side of the circuit.
ES
Reference (Bank 1 Sensor 2 System Diagram)
EFI M
From
Battery
+B
EFI
ECM
Heated Oxygen Sensor
HT
HT1B
Heater
E
OX
OX1B
Sensor
Ground
Ground
Duty
Control
MREL
A073886E01
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0037
Heater current is less than 0.3 A when the
heater operates with +B greater than 10.5 V
(1 trip detection logic)
•
When the heater operates, heater current
exceeds 2 A
(1 trip detection logic)
•
P0038
•
•
•
•
•
•
Open or short in heater circuit of the
heated oxygen sensor
Heated oxygen sensor heater
EFI M relay (integration relay)
ECM
Short in heater circuit of the heated
oxygen sensor
Heated oxygen sensor heater
EFI M relay (integration relay)
ECM
HINT:
• Sensor 1 refers to the sensor mounted before the TWC and is located near the engine assembly.
• Sensor 2 refers to the sensor mounted after the TWC and is located far from the engine assembly.
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The sensing portion of the heated oxygen sensor has a zirconia element which is used to detect oxygen
concentration in the exhaust gas. If the zirconia element is at the proper temperature and difference of the
oxygen concentration between the inside and outside surfaces of sensor is large, the zirconia element will
generate voltage signals. In order to increase the oxygen concentration detecting capacity in the zirconia
element, the ECM supplements the heat from the exhaust with heat from a heating element inside the
sensor. When current in the sensor is out of the standard operating range, the ECM interprets this as a
fault in the heated oxygen sensor and sets a DTC.
Example:
ES–78
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
The ECM will set a high current DTC if the current in the sensor is more than 2 A when the heater is OFF.
Similarly, the ECM will set a low current DTC if the current is less than 0.25 A when the heater is ON.
MONITOR STRATEGY
ES
Related DTCs
P0037: Heated oxygen sensor heater current bank 1 sensor 2 (low
current)
P0038: Heated oxygen sensor heater current bank 1 sensor 2 (high
current)
Required sensors/components
Main sensors:
Heated oxygen sensor
Related sensors:
Vehicle speed sensor
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
0.5 seconds
MIL operation
1 driving cycle
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
Monitor runs whenever following DTCs not present
None
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
Engine
Running
Starter
OFF
Catalyst intrusive monitoring
Not operating
Intrusive heating
Not operating
P0037:
When the following conditions are met
0.5 seconds or more
Learned heater current during heater OFF
Completed
Intrusive heating
Not operating
Heating is OFF
Less than 0.1 seconds
Heater current
Less than 0.3 A
Intrusive heating for high current monitor
Not operating
Time after heaters are OFF
1 second or more
P0038:
When the following conditions are met
0.3 seconds or more
Learned heater current during heater OFF
Completed
Intrusive heating
Not operating
Heating is OFF
Less than 0.1 seconds
Heater current
2 A or more
Time after heaters are OFF
1 second or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P0037:
Heated oxygen sensor heater current
Less than 0.3 A (at 0.5 seconds after heater is turned ON)
P0038:
Heated oxygen sensor heater current
More than 2 A (while supplemental heating is OFF)
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–79
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Heated oxygen sensor heater current
(after engine is warmed up)
0.4 to 1.0 A (at idle and battery voltage 11 to 14 V)
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to detailed information (see page ES-15).
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0136 (see page ES-121).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine condition
when malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the
vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or
rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
• When DTC P0038 is detected, proceed to step 4 if the heater resistance is in normal range.
1
INSPECT HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (HEATER RESISTANCE)
Component Side
+B
H13
E
2
1
4
3
Front View
HT Heated
Oxygen
Sensor
OX
(a) Disconnect the H13 heated oxygen sensor connector.
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the
heated oxygen sensor connector.
Standard resistance (Bank 1 sensor 2):
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
H13-1 (HT) - H13-2 (+B)
11 to 16 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
H13-1 (HT) - H13-4 (E)
10 kΩ or higher
(c) Reconnect the heated oxygen sensor connector.
A062378E29
NG
OK
REPLACE HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
ES
ES–80
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
2
INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY (EFI M RELAY)
Integration Relay
Connector
IGCT
ES
HORN
AM2
IG2
EFI
EFI M
Relay Detail
6
7
8
1
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3K-1 - 3I-8
10 kΩ or higher
3K-1 - 3I-8
Below 1 Ω
(Apply battery voltage to terminals
3I-6 and 3I-7)
(c) Reinstall the integration relay.
3I
3I
3I
3K
8
7
6
1
(a) Remove the integration relay from the engine room relay
block.
(b) Inspect the EFI M relay.
Standard resistance
NG
REPLACE INTEGRATION RELAY
3I
3I
3I
3K
A082812E01
OK
3
CHECK ECM (HT1B VOLTAGE)
E4
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Measure the voltage between the applicable terminals of
the E4 and E6 ECM connectors.
Standard voltage
E6
E2 (-)
HT1B (+)
Specified Condition
E6-6 (HT1B) - E4-28 (E2)
9 to 14 V
OK
ECM Connector
A119979E46
NG
Tester Connection
REPLACE ECM
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
4
ES–81
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR - ECM AND EFI M
RELAY)
(a) Check the harness and the connectors between the
ECM and the heated oxygen sensor connectors.
(1) Disconnect the H13 heated oxygen sensor
connector.
Wire Harness Side
+B
HT
Front View
H13
OX
E
Heated Oxygen Sensor Connector
ES
A066283E03
E4
(2) Disconnect the E4 and E6 ECM connectors.
(3) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E6
E2
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
H13-1 (HT) - E6-6 (HT1B)
Below 1 Ω
H13-4 (E) - E4-28 (E2)
Below 1 Ω
HT1B
ECM Connector
Standard resistance (Check for short)
A079127E03
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
H13-1 (HT) or E6-6 (HT1B) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
H13-1 (HT) - H13-2 (+B)
10 kΩ or higher
(4) Reconnect the heated oxygen sensor connector.
(5) Reconnect the ECM connectors.
(b) Check the harness and the connectors between the
heated oxygen sensor connector and the EFI M relay.
(1) Disconnect the H13 heated oxygen sensor
connector.
(2) Remove the integration relay from the engine room
relay block.
(3) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
8 3I
Engine Room Relay Block
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
H13-2 (+B) - 3I-8 (EFI M relay)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
A082810E01
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
H13-2 (+B) or 3I-8 (EFI M relay) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(4) Reconnect the heated oxygen sensor connector.
(5) Reinstall the integration relay.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
ES–82
OK
REPLACE ECM
ES
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0100
Mass or Volume Air Flow Circuit
DTC
P0102
Mass or Volume Air Flow Circuit Low Input
DTC
P0103
Mass or Volume Air Flow Circuit High Input
ES–83
DESCRIPTION
The MAF (Mass Air Flow) meter measures the amount of air flowing through the throttle valve. The ECM
uses this information to determine the fuel injection time and provides a proper air-fuel ratio. Inside the
MAF meter, there is a heated platinum wire exposed to the flow of intake air.
By applying a specific current to the wire, the ECM heats this wire to a given temperature. The flow of
incoming air cools the wire and an internal thermistor, affecting their resistance. To maintain a constant
current value, the ECM varies the voltage applied to these components in the MAF meter. The voltage
level is proportional to the air flowing through the sensor. The ECM interprets this voltage as the intake air
amount.
The circuit is constructed so that the platinum hot wire and temperature sensor provide a bridge circuit,
and the power transistor is controlled so that the potential of A and B remains equal to maintain the set
temperature.
+B
Temperature Sensor
Power Transistor
Platinum Hot Wire
(Heater)
A
B
Output
Voltage
Temperature
Sensor
Platinum Hot Wire (Heater)
A080089E02
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0100
When the mass air flow meter circuit has an
open or a short for more than 3 seconds
•
•
•
Open or short in mass air flow meter
circuit
Mass air flow meter
ECM
P0102
When the mass air flow meter circuit has an
open for more than 3 seconds
•
•
•
Open or in mass air flow meter circuit
Mass air flow meter
ECM
P0103
When the mass air flow meter circuit has a
short for more than 3 seconds
•
•
•
Short in mass air flow meter circuit
Mass air flow meter
ECM
HINT:
After confirming DTC P0100, P0102 or P0103, confirm the mass air flow ratio in DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY.
Air Flow Rate (g/sec.)
Malfunction
Approximately 0.0
•
•
Mass air flow meter power source circuit open
VG circuit open or short
271.0 or more
•
E2G circuit open
ES
ES–84
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
If there is a defect in the sensor or an open or short circuit, the voltage level will deviate from the normal
operating range. The ECM interprets this deviation as a defect in the MAF meter and sets a DTC.
Example:
When the sensor voltage output is less than 0.2 V or more than 4.9 V and if either condition continues for
more than 3 seconds.
MONITOR STRATEGY
ES
Related DTCs
P0100: Mass air flow meter circuit range check (fluttering)
P0102: Mass air flow meter circuit range check (low voltage)
P0103: Mass air flow meter circuit range check (high voltage)
Required sensors/components
Mass air flow meter
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
3 seconds
MIL operation
Immediately (when engine speed is less than 4,000 rpm)
2 driving cycles (when engine speed is 4,000 rpm or more)
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
None
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P0100:
Mass air flow meter voltage
Less than 0.2 V or more than 4.9 V
P0102:
Mass air flow meter voltage
Less than 0.2 V
P0103:
Mass air flow meter voltage
More than 4.9 V
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Mass air flow meter voltage
0.4 to 2.2 V
ES–85
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Integration Relay
Mass Air Flow Meter
ECM
Shielded
EFI
+B
EFI M
VG
VG
E2G
EVG
ES
P/I
MAIN
MREL
A127903E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine condition when
malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was
running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or rich, and other data
from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (MASS AIR FLOW RATE)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Put the engine in inspection mode (see page ES-1).
Start the engine.
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY / MAF.
Read its value using the intelligent tester.
Result
Air Flow Rate (g/sec.)
Proceed to
0.0
A
271.0 or more
B
Between 1.0 and 270.0 (*)
C
ES–86
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
HINT:
*: The value must be changed when the throttle valve is
opened or closed.
B
C
Go to step 6
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
A
2
ES
INSPECT MASS AIR FLOW METER (POWER SOURCE)
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Disconnect the M1 mass air flow meter connector.
(c) Measure the voltage between the terminal of the wire
harness side connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
Mass Air Flow Sensor Connector
M1
+B (+)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
M1-1 (+B) - Body ground
9 to 14 V
(d) Reconnect the mass air flow meter connector.
Front View
A054396E54
NG
Go to step 5
OK
3
CHECK ECM (VG VOLTAGE)
(a) Put the engine in inspection mode (see page ES-1).
(b) Start the engine.
(c) Measure the voltage between the specified terminals of
the E5 ECM connector.
HINT:
The A/C switch should be turned OFF.
Standard voltage
E5
VG (+) EVG (-)
ECM Connector
A124045E01
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
E5-33 (VG) - E5-32
(EVG)
Engine is idling
0.5 to 3.0 V
OK
NG
REPLACE ECM
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
4
ES–87
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (MASS AIR FLOW METER - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the M1 mass air flow meter connector.
Wire Harness Side
Mass Air Flow Sensor Connector
M1
E2G
VG
Front View
ES
A054396E55
(b) Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E5
Tester Connection
VG
EVG
ECM Connector
Specified Condition
M1-3 (VG) - E5-33 (VG)
Below 1 Ω
M1-2 (E2G) - E5-32 (EVG)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
A065745E33
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
M1-3 (VG) or E5-33 (VG) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the mass air flow meter connector.
(e) Reconnect the ECM connector.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE MASS AIR FLOW METER
5
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (MASS AIR FLOW METER - EFI M RELAY)
(a) Remove the integration relay from the engine room relay
block.
8 3I
Engine Room Relay Block
A082810E01
ES–88
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(b) Disconnect the M1 mass air flow meter connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Wire Harness Side
Mass Air Flow Meter Connector
M1
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
M1-1 (+B) - 3I-8 (EFI M relay)
Below 1 Ω
+B
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Front View
A054396E56
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
M1-1 (+B) or 3I-8 (EFI M relay) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the mass air flow meter connector.
(e) Reinstall the integration relay.
ES
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
CHECK ECM POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT
6
CHECK ECM (SENSOR GROUND)
(a) Measure the resistance between the specified terminal
of the E5 ECM connector and the body ground.
Standard resistance
E5
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E5-32 (EVG) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
EVG
ECM Connector
REPLACE ECM
A124045E02
OK
7
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (MASS AIR FLOW METER - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the M1 mass air flow meter connector.
Wire Harness Side
Mass Air Flow Meter Connector
M1
+B
E2G
VG
Front View
A054396E57
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(b) Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E5
Tester Connection
VG
ES–89
EVG
ECM Connector
Specified Condition
M1-3 (VG) - E5-33 (VG)
Below 1 Ω
M1-2 (E2G) - E5-32 (EVG)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
A065745E33
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
M1-3 (VG) or E5-33 (VG) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the mass air flow meter connector.
(e) Reconnect the ECM connector.
NG
OK
REPLACE MASS AIR FLOW METER
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
ES
ES–90
DTC
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
P0101
Mass Air Flow Circuit Range / Performance
Problem
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0100 (see page ES-76).
ES
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0101
MAF meter voltage is higher than MAF meter
voltage based on throttle position when the
following conditions are met
(2 trip detection logic):
• Engine coolant temperature is 70°C
(158°F) or more
• Engine speed is less than 2,000 rpm
•
Mass air flow meter
P0101
MAF meter voltage is lower than MAF meter
voltage based on throttle position when the
following conditions are met
(2 trip detection logic):
• Fuel cut is not executing
• Engine speed is more than 300 rpm
•
Mass air flow meter
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The MAF (Mass Air Flow) meter is a sensor that helps the ECM calculates the amount of air flowing
through the throttle valve. The ECM uses this information to determine the fuel injection time and provide
a proper air-fuel ratio. Inside the MAF meter, there is a heated platinum wire exposed to the flow of intake
air. By applying a specific current to the wire, the ECM heats this wire to a given temperature. The flow of
incoming air cools the wire and an internal thermistor, changing their resistance. To maintain a constant
current value, the ECM varies the voltage applied to these components in the MAF meter. The voltage
level is proportional to the air flow through the sensor and the ECM interprets this voltage as the intake air
amount. If there is a defect in the sensor or an open or short circuit, the voltage level will deviate from the
normal operating range. The ECM interprets this deviation as a defect in the MAF meter and sets a DTC.
Example:
If the MAF meter voltage is higher than 2.2 V when the engine is idling, the ECM sets P0101 (2 trip
detection logic). If the MAF meter voltage is higher than 0.9 V when the throttle valve is opened, the ECM
sets P0101 (2 trip detection logic).
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0101: Mass air flow meter rationality
Required sensors/components
Main sensors:
Mass air flow meter
Related sensors:
Engine speed sensor, engine coolant temperature sensor, throttle
position sensor
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
10 seconds
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
P0115 - P0118 (ECT sensor)
P0120 - P0223, P2135 (TP sensor)
P0125 (Insufficient ECT for closed loop)
P0335 (CKP sensor)
P0340, P0341 (CMP sensor)
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–91
Case1: Mass air flow meter rationality (High voltage)
Engine speed
Less than 2,000 rpm
Engine coolant temperature
70°C(158°F) or more
Case2: Mass air flow meter rationality (Low voltage)
Engine speed
More than 300 rpm
Fuel cut
OFF
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Case1: Mass air flow meter rationality (High voltage)
Mass air flow meter voltage
More than 2.2 V (varies with throttle position)
Case2: Mass air flow meter rationality (Low voltage)
Mass air flow meter voltage
Less than 0.9 V (varies with throttle position)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0100 (see page ES-78).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine condition when
malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was
running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or rich, and other data
from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
CHECK OTHER DTC OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P0101)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC output)
Proceed to
P0101 and other DTCs
A
P0101
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides P0101 are output, perform
troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
B
A
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
REPLACE MASS AIR FLOW METER
ES
ES–92
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0110
Intake Air Temperature Circuit
DTC
P0112
Intake Air Temperature Circuit Low Input
DTC
P0113
Intake Air Temperature Circuit High Input
DESCRIPTION
(Figure 1)
Resistance KΩ
ES
Acceptable
Temperature °C (°F)
A094266E01
The intake air temperature (IAT) sensor, mounted on the mass air flow (MAF) meter, monitors the intake
air temperature. The IAT sensor has a thermistor that varies its resistance depending on the temperature
of the intake air. When the air temperature is low, the resistance in the thermistor increases. When the
temperature is high, the resistance drops. The variations in resistance are reflected as voltage changes to
the ECM terminal (see Figure 1).
The intake air temperature sensor is connected to the ECM (see wiring diagram). The 5 V power source
voltage in the ECM is applied to the intake air temperature sensor from terminal THA (THAR) via resistor
R.
That is, the resistor R and the intake air temperature sensor are connected in series. When the resistance
value of the intake air temperature sensor changes in accordance with changes in the intake air
temperature, the voltage at terminal THA (THAR) also changes. Based on this signal, the ECM increases
the fuel injection volume to improve the driveability during cold engine operation.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0110
Open or short in intake air temperature sensor
circuit for 0.5 seconds
•
•
•
P0112
Short in intake air temperature sensor circuit
for 0.5 seconds
•
•
•
Open or short in intake air temperature
sensor circuit
Intake air temperature sensor (built in
mass air flow meter)
ECM
Short in intake air temperature sensor
circuit
Intake air temperature sensor (built in
mass air flow meter)
ECM
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0113
Open in intake air temperature sensor circuit
for 0.5 seconds
•
•
•
ES–93
Open in intake air temperature sensor
circuit
Intake air temperature sensor (built in
mass air flow meter)
ECM
HINT:
After confirming DTC P0110, P0112 or P0113, confirm the intake air temperature in DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY using the intelligent tester.
Temperature Displayed
Malfunction
-40°C (-40°F)
Open circuit
140°C (284°F)
Short circuit
ES
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM monitors the sensor voltage and uses this value to calculate the intake air temperature. When
the sensor output voltage deviates from the normal operating range, the ECM interprets this as a fault in
the IAT sensor and sets a DTC.
Example:
When the sensor voltage output is equal to -40°C (-40°F), or more than 140°C (284°F), and either
condition continues for 0.5 seconds or more.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0110: Intake air temperature sensor range check (fluttering)
P0112: Intake air temperature sensor range check (low resistance)
P0113: Intake air temperature sensor range check (high resistance)
Required sensors/components
Intake air temperature sensor
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
0.5 seconds
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
None
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P0110: Intake air temperature sensor range check (fluttering)
Intake air temperature sensor voltage
(Intake air temperature)
Less than 0.18 V or more than 4.91 V
(More than 140°C (284°F) or -40°C (-40°F) or less)
P0112: Intake air temperature sensor range check (low resistance)
Intake air temperature sensor voltage
(Intake air temperature)
Less than 0.18 V
(More than 140°C (284°F))
P0113: Intake air temperature sensor range check (high resistance)
Intake air temperature sensor voltage
(Intake air temperature)
More than 4.91 V
(-40°C (-40°F) or less)
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Intake air temperature sensor resistance
98.5 Ω (140°C (284°F)) to 156 kΩ (-40°C (-40°F))
ES–94
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Intake Air Temperature Sensor
(Built into Mass Air Flow Meter)
ECM
5V
THA
THA
E2
R
E2
ES
A119255E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• If DTCs related to different systems that have terminal E2 as the ground terminal are output
simultaneously, terminal E2 may have an open circuit.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine condition
when malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the
vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or
rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
READ OUTPUT DTC
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and turn the intelligent
tester ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(d) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed To
P0110/24
A
P0112/24
B
P0113/24
C
B
Go to step 5
C
Go to step 3
A
2
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–95
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY / INTAKE AIR.
(e) Read the value.
Temperature value:
Same as the ambient air temperature.
Result
Temperature Displayed
Proceed to
-40°C (-40°F)
A
140°C (284°F)
B
OK (Same as ambient air
temperature)
C
HINT:
• If there is an open circuit, the intelligent tester
indicates -40°C (-40°F).
• If there is a short circuit, the intelligent tester indicates
140°C (284°F).
B
C
Go to step 5
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
A
3
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (CHECK FOR OPEN IN WIRE HARNESS)
Mass Air Flow
Meter Connector
(a) Disconnect the M1 mass air flow meter connector.
ECM
M1
THA
E2
A083861E03
(b) Connect terminals THA and E2 of the mass air flow
meter wire harness side connector.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY / INTAKE AIR. Read the
value.
OK:
Temperature value: 140°C (284°F)
(e) Reconnect the mass air flow meter connector.
Wire Harness Side
Mass Air Flow Meter Connector
M1
THA
E2
Front View
A054396E58
NG
OK
CONFIRM GOOD CONNECTION AT
SENSOR. IF OK, REPLACE MASS AIR FLOW
METER
ES
ES–96
4
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (CHECK FOR OPEN IN ECM)
Mass Air Flow
Meter Connector
(a) Disconnect the M1 mass air flow meter connector.
ECM
M1
THA
E2
ES
A083862E04
E4
THA
E2
ECM Connector
A124045E03
(b) Connect terminals THA and E2 of the E4 ECM
connector.
HINT:
Before checking, do a visual and contact pressure check
for the ECM connector.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY / INTAKE AIR. Read the
value.
OK:
Temperature value: 140°C (284°F)
(e) Reconnect the mass air flow meter connector.
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
NG
CONFIRM GOOD CONNECTION AT ECM. IF OK, REPLACE ECM
5
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (CHECK FOR SHORT IN WIRE HARNESS)
Mass Air Flow
Meter Connector
ECM
M1
THA
E2
A083863E14
NG
(a) Disconnect the M1 mass air flow meter connector.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY / INTAKE AIR.
(d) Read the value.
OK:
Temperature value: -40°C (-40°F)
(e) Reconnect the mass air flow meter connector.
OK
REPLACE MASS AIR FLOW METER
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
6
ES–97
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (CHECK FOR SHORT IN ECM)
Mass Air Flow
Meter Connector
(a) Disconnect the E4 ECM connector.
ECM
M1
THA
E2
ES
A083864E03
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY / INTAKE AIR.
(d) Read the value.
OK:
Temperature value: -40°C (-40°F)
(e) Reconnect the mass air flow meter connector.
E4
OK
ECM Connector
NG
REPLACE ECM
A065743E68
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
ES–98
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0115
Engine Coolant Temperature Circuit
DTC
P0117
Engine Coolant Temperature Circuit Low Input
DTC
P0118
Engine Coolant Temperature Circuit High Input
DESCRIPTION
ES
A thermistor is built in the engine coolant temperature sensor and changes its resistance value according
to the engine coolant temperature.
The structure of the sensor and connection to the ECM is the same as those of the intake air temperature
sensor.
HINT:
If the ECM detects DTC P0115, P0117 or P0118, it operates the fail-safe function in which the engine
coolant temperature is assumed to be 80°C (176°F).
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0115
Open or short in engine coolant temperature
sensor circuit for 0.5 seconds
•
•
•
P0117
Short in engine coolant temperature sensor
circuit for 0.5 seconds
•
•
•
P0118
Open in engine coolant temperature sensor
circuit for 0.5 seconds
•
•
•
Open or short in engine coolant
temperature sensor circuit
Engine coolant temperature sensor
ECM
Short in engine coolant temperature
sensor circuit
Engine coolant temperature sensor
ECM
Open in engine coolant temperature
sensor circuit
Engine coolant temperature sensor
ECM
HINT:
After confirming DTC P0115, P0117 or P0118, confirm the engine coolant temperature from DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY using the intelligent tester.
Temperature Displayed
Malfunction
-40°C (-40°F)
Open circuit
140°C (284°F)
Short circuit
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor is used to monitor the engine coolant temperature. The
ECT sensor has a thermistor that varies its resistance depending on the temperature of the engine
coolant. When the coolant temperature is low, the resistance in the thermistor increases. When the
temperature is high, the resistance drops. The variations in resistance are reflected in the voltage output
from the sensor. The ECM monitors the sensor voltage and uses this value to calculate the engine coolant
temperature. When the sensor output voltage deviates from the normal operating range, the ECM
interprets this as a fault in the ECT sensor and sets a DTC.
Example:
When the ECM calculates that the ECT is -40°C (-40°F), or more than 140°C (284°F), and if either
condition continues for 0.5 second or more, the ETC will set a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0115: Engine coolant temperature sensor range check (fluttering)
P0117: Engine coolant temperature sensor range check (low
resistance)
P0118: Engine coolant temperature sensor range check (high
resistance)
ES–99
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Required sensors/components
Engine coolant temperature sensor
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
0.5 seconds
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
None
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P0115:
Engine coolant temperature sensor voltage
(coolant temperature)
ES
Less than 0.14 V or more than 4.91 V
(More than 140°C (284°F) or -40°C (-40°F) or less)
P0117:
Engine coolant temperature sensor voltage
(coolant temperature)
Less than 0.14 V
(More than 140°C (284°F))
P0118:
Engine coolant temperature sensor voltage
(coolant temperature)
More than 4.91 V
(-40°C (-40°F) or less)
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Engine coolant temperature sensor resistance
79 Ω (140°C (284°F)) to 156 kΩ (-40°C (-40°F))
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
5V
THW
R
E2
A119255E03
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• If DTCs related to different systems that have terminal E2 as the ground terminal are output
simultaneously, terminal E2 may have an open circuit.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine condition
when malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the
vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or
rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
ES–100
1
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
READ OUTPUT DTC
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and turn the intelligent
tester ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(d) Read DTCs.
Result
ES
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed To
P0115/24
A
P0117/24
B
P0118/24
C
B
Go to step 5
C
Go to step 3
A
2
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY / COOLANT TEMP.
(e) Read the value.
(f) Measure the coolant temperature using a thermometer
and compare the value with the value displayed on the
intelligent tester.
Temperature value:
Almost same as the actual engine coolant
temperature.
Result
Temperature Displayed
Proceed to
-40°C (-40°F)
A
140°C (284°F)
B
OK (Same as actual engine coolant
temperature)
C
HINT:
• If there is an open circuit, the intelligent tester
indicates -40°C (-40°F).
• If there is a short circuit, the intelligent tester indicates
140°C (284°F).
B
C
Go to step 5
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–101
A
3
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (CHECK FOR OPEN IN WIRE HARNESS)
Engine Coolant
Temperature Sensor
ECM
(a) Disconnect the E1 engine coolant temperature sensor
connector.
E1
THW
E2
ES
A083861E04
Wire Harness Side
Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor
Connector
E1
Front View
A082813E01
(b) Connect terminals 1 and 2 of the engine coolant
temperature sensor wire harness side connector.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY / COOLANT TEMP.
Read the value.
OK:
Temperature value: 140°C (284°F)
(e) Reconnect the engine coolant temperature sensor
connector.
OK
CONFIRM GOOD CONNECTION AT
SENSOR. IF OK, REPLACE ENGINE
COOLANT TEMP. SENSOR
NG
4
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (CHECK FOR OPEN IN ECM)
Engine Coolant
Temperature Sensor
ECM
E1
THW
E2
A083862E05
(a) Disconnect the E1 engine coolant temperature sensor
connector.
ES–102
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
E4
THW
E2
ECM Connector
A124045E04
ES
(b) Connect terminals THW and E2 of the E4 ECM
connector.
HINT:
Before checking, do a visual and contact pressure check
on the ECM connector.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY / COOLANT TEMP.
Read the value.
OK:
Temperature value: 140°C (284°F)
(e) Reconnect the engine coolant temperature sensor
connector.
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
NG
CONFIRM GOOD CONNECTION AT ECM. IF OK, REPLACE ECM
5
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (CHECK FOR SHORT IN WIRE HARNESS)
Engine Coolant
Temperature Sensor
ECM
E1
THW
E2
A083863E15
(a) Disconnect the E1 engine coolant temperature sensor
connector.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY / COOLANT TEMP.
(d) Read the value.
OK:
Temperature value: -40°C (-40°F)
(e) Reconnect the engine coolant temperature sensor
connector.
OK
REPLACE ENGINE COOLANT
TEMPERATURE SENSOR
NG
6
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (CHECK FOR SHORT IN ECM)
Engine Coolant
Temperature Sensor
(a) Disconnect the E4 ECM connector.
ECM
E1
THW
E2
A083864E04
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–103
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY / COOLANT TEMP.
(d) Read the value.
OK:
Temperature value: -40°C (-40°F)
(e) Reconnect the ECM connector.
E4
OK
ECM Connector
A065743E68
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
NG
REPLACE ECM
ES
ES–104
DTC
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
P0116
Engine Coolant Temperature Circuit Range /
Performance Problem
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0115 (see page ES-91).
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0116
If the engine coolant temperature (ECT) was
between 35°C (95°F) and 60°C (140°F) when
starting the engine, and conditions (a) and (b)
are met (2 trip detection logic):
(a) Vehicle is driven at varying speeds
(acceleration and deceleration) for more than
250 seconds
(b) ECT remains within 3°C (5.4°F) of the
engine starting temperature
•
Engine coolant temperature sensor
P0116
If the engine coolant temperature was more
than 60°C (140°F) at engine start, and
conditions (a) and (b) are met (6 trip detection
logic):
(a) Vehicle is driven at varying speeds (under
acceleration and deceleration)
(b) Engine coolant temperature remains
within 1°C (1.8°F) of the engine starting
temperature, and this is successively
recorded 6 times
•
Engine coolant temperature sensor
ES
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor is used to monitor the engine coolant temperature. The
ECT sensor has a thermistor that varies its resistance depending on the temperature of the engine
coolant. When the coolant temperature is low, the resistance in the thermistor increases. When the
temperature is high, the resistance drops. The variations in resistance are reflected in the voltage output
from the sensor. The ECM monitors the sensor voltage and uses this value to calculate the engine coolant
temperature. When the sensor output voltage deviates from the normal operating range, the ECM
interprets this as a fault in the ECT sensor and sets a DTC.
Examples:
1) Upon starting the engine, the coolant temperature (ECT) was between 35°C (95°F) and 60°C (140°F).
If after driving for 250 seconds, the ECT still remains within 3°C (5.4°F) of the starting temperature, a DTC
will be set (2 trip detection logic).
2) Upon starting the engine, the coolant temperature (ECT) was over 60°C (140°F). If, after driving for 250
seconds, the ECT still remains within 1°C (1.8°F) of the starting temperature, a DTC will be set (6 trip
detection logic).
MONITOR STRATEGY
Case 1: ECT is between 35 and 60°C (95 and 140°F)
Related DTCs
P0116
Required sensors/components (Main)
Engine coolant temperature sensor
Required sensors/components (Related)
-
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
1 second
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of operation
None
Case 2: ECT is higher than 60°C (140°F)
Related DTCs
P0116
Required sensors/components (Main)
Engine coolant temperature sensor
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Required sensors/components (Related)
-
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
0.032 second
MIL operation
6 driving cycles
Sequence of operation
None
ES–105
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
Case 1: ECT is between 35 and 60°C (95 and 140°F)
Monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
P0100, P0101, P0102, P0103
Cumulative idle off period
250 seconds or more
Frequency of the following condition (a) is met
10 times
(a) Vehicle speed increase
19 mph (30 km/h) or more
Engine coolant temperature
35 to 60°C (95 to 140°F)
Intake air temperature
-6.7°C (20°F) or higher
Case 2: ECT is higher than 60°C (140°F)
Monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
P0100, P0101, P0102, P0103
Engine coolant temperature
60°C (140°F) or higher
Intake air temperature
-6.7°C (20°F) or higher
Frequency that vehicle is driven by the following conditions (a) to (d) is
met
Once
(a) Engine idling period
20 seconds or more
(b) Acceleration period: Duration that vehicle speed reaches to 70 km/
h (43.5 mph)
Within 40 seconds
(c) Intake air temperature: Duration that vehicle is driven by 65 to 70
km/h (40 to 43.5 mph)
30 seconds or more
(d) Intake air temperature: Duration that vehicle speed drops to 3 km/h
(2 mph)
Within 35 seconds
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Case 1: ECT is between 35 and 60°C (95 and 140°F)
Engine coolant temperature change after engine start
Less than 3°C (5.4°F)
Case 2: ECT is higher than 60°C (140°F)
Engine coolant temperature change after engine start
1°C (1.8°F) or less
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Engine coolant temperature
Changing with the actual engine coolant temperature
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0115 (see page ES-92).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ OUTPUT DTC
(a) Connect an intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch on (IG) and turn the tester on.
(c) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
ES
ES–106
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(d) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed To
P0116
A
P0116 and other DTCs
B
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
A
2
ES
INSPECT THERMOSTAT
(a) Remove the thermostat (see page CO-14).
(b) Measure the valve opening temperature of the
thermostat.
Standard temperature:
80°C to 84°C (176°F to 183°F)
HINT:
In addition to the above check, confirm that the valve is
completely closed when the temperature is below the
standard.
(c) Reinstall the thermostat (see page CO-16).
NG
REPLACE THERMOSTAT
OK
REPLACE ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–107
DTC
P0120
Throttle Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "A" Circuit Malfunction
DTC
P0122
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "A"
Circuit Low Input
DTC
P0123
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "A"
Circuit High Input
DTC
P0220
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "B"
Circuit
DTC
P0222
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "B"
Circuit Low Input
DTC
P0223
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "B"
Circuit High Input
DTC
P2135
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "A" /
"B" Voltage Correlation
DESCRIPTION
HINT:
• This electrical throttle system does not use a throttle cable.
• This is the troubleshooting procedure of the throttle position sensor.
The throttle position sensor is mounted on the throttle body and it has 2 sensor terminals to detect the
throttle opening angle and malfunction of the throttle position sensor itself.
The voltage applied to terminals VTA and VTA2 of the ECM changes between 0 V and 5 V in proportion to
the opening angle of the throttle valve. The VTA is a signal to indicate the actual throttle valve opening
angle which is used for the engine control, and the VTA2 is a signal to indicate the information about the
opening angle which is used for detecting malfunction of the sensor.
The ECM judges the current opening angle of the throttle valve from these signals input from terminals
VTA and VTA2, and the ECM controls the throttle motor to make the throttle valve angle properly in
response to the driving condition.
When malfunction is detected, the throttle valve is locked at a certain opening angle. Also, the whole
electronically controlled throttle operation is canceled until the system returns to normal and the power
switch is turned OFF.
ES
ES–108
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
*2
*1
Movable Range
Movable Range
Usable Range
Usable Range
*1
*2
E2
ES
VTA2
VTA1
VC
Throttle Position Sensor Output Voltage (V)
5
*1 *3
*2
VTA2
2.40
1.5
VTA1
0.81
0
Fail Safe Angle
21
70
Usable Range
125
Throttle Valve Opening
Angle (deg.)
*1: Throttle Valve Fully Closed (13.5°), VTA1 is 0%
*2: Throttle Valve Fully Open (97.5°), VTA1 is approximately 0%
*3: Fail Safe Angle (16.5°), VTA1 is 3.5%
Note: Throttle valve opening angle detected by the sensor terminal of VTA is expressed as percentage.
A071013E01
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
-
Conditions of DTC P0120, P0122, P0123,
P0220, P0222 or P0223 continues for 2
seconds or more when Idle is ON
-
P0120
Detection conditions for DTCs P0122 and
P0123 are not satisfied but condition (a) is
satisfied
(a) VTA is 0.2V or less, or 4.535 V or more
•
•
•
Open or short in throttle position sensor
circuit
Throttle position sensor
ECM
P0122
VTA is 0.2 V or less
•
•
•
Short in throttle position sensor circuit
Throttle position sensor
ECM
P0123
VTA is 4.535 V or more
•
•
•
Open in throttle position sensor circuit
Throttle position sensor
ECM
P0220
Detection conditions for DTCs P0222 and
P0223 are not satisfied but condition satisfied
VTA2 is 1.75 V or less, or VTA2 is 4.8 V or
more
•
Open or short in throttle position sensor
circuit
Throttle position sensor
ECM
•
•
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–109
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0222
VTA2 is 1.75 V or less
•
•
•
Short in throttle position sensor circuit
Throttle position sensor
ECM
P0223
VTA2 is 4.8 V or more when VTA is 0.2 or
more and 2.02 V or less
•
•
•
Open in throttle position sensor circuit
Throttle position sensor
ECM
P2135
Condition (a) continues for 0.5 seconds or
more, or condition (b) continues for 0.4
seconds or more:
(a) Difference between VTA and VTA2 is 0.02
V or less
(b) VTA is 0.2 V or less and VTA2 is 1.75 V or
less
•
Open or short in throttle position sensor
circuit
Throttle position sensor
ECM
•
•
HINT:
ES
DTC No.
Main Trouble Area
P0122
•
•
•
•
Throttle position sensor
Open in VTA1 circuit
VC circuit open (when the VC circuit is open, DTCs P0222 and
P2135 are also output simultaneously)
ECM
P0123
•
•
•
•
•
Throttle position sensor (built in throttle body)
Open in VTA circuit
Open in E2 circuit
VC and VTA circuits are short-circuited
ECM
P0222
•
•
•
Throttle position sensor
Open in VTA2 circuit
VC circuit open (when the VC circuit is open, DTCs P0122 and
P2135 are also output simultaneously)
P0223
•
Throttle position sensor
P2135
•
•
•
VTA1 and VTA2 circuits are short-circuited
Open in VC circuit
Throttle position sensor
NOTICE:
When a malfunction is detected, the throttle valve is locked at a certain opening angle. Also, the
whole electronically controlled throttle operation is canceled until the system returns to normal
and the power switch is turned OFF.
HINT:
• After confirming DTCs, confirm condition of the throttle valve opening angle (THROTTLE POS) and the
closed throttle position switch (THROTTLE POS #2) using the intelligent tester.
• THROTTLE POS means the VTA1 signal (expressed as percentage), and THROTTLE POS#2 means
the VTA2 signal (expressed as volts).
Tester display
Accelerator pedal released
Accelerator pedal depressed
THROTTLE POS
8 to 20%
64 to 96%
THROTTLE POS #2
1.5 to 2.9 V
3.5 to 5.5 V
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM uses the throttle position sensor to monitor the throttle valve opening angle.
(a) There is a specific voltage difference between VTA1 and VTA2 for each throttle opening angle.
(b) VTA1 and VTA2 each have a specific voltage operating range.
(c) VTA1 and VTA2 should never be close to the same voltage level.
If the difference between VTA1 and VTA2 is incorrect (a), the ECM interprets this as a fault and will set a
DTC.
If VTA1 or VTA2 is out of the normal operating range (b), the ECM interprets this as a fault and will set a
DTC.
ES–110
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
If VTA1 is within 0.02 V of VTA2 (c), the ECM interprets this as a short circuit in the throttle position sensor
system and will set a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
ES
Related DTCs
P0120: Throttle position sensor (sensor 1) range check (fluttering)
P0122: Throttle position sensor (sensor 1) range check (low voltage)
P0123: Throttle position sensor (sensor 1) range check (high voltage)
P0220: Throttle position sensor (sensor 2) range check (fluttering)
P0222: Throttle position sensor (sensor 2) range check (low voltage)
P0223: Throttle position sensor (sensor 2) range check (high voltage)
P2135: Throttle position sensor range check (correlation)
Required sensors/components
Throttle position sensor
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
2 seconds
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
None
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P0120:
VTA1 voltage
0.2 V or less or 4.535 V or more
P0122:
VTA1 voltage
0.2 V or less
P0123:
VTA1 voltage
4.535 V or more
P0220:
VTA2 voltage
1.75 V or less or 4.8 V or more
P0222:
VTA2 voltage
1.75 V or less
P0223:
VTA2 voltage
4.8 V or more (VTA voltage is 0.2 and 2.02 V)
P2135:
Different between VTA1 and VTA2 voltage
0.02 V or less
Both of the following conditions are met:
(a) and (b)
(a) VTA1 voltage
0.2 V or less
(b) VTA2 voltage
1.75 V or less
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Throttle position sensor VTA1 voltage
0.6 to 3.96 V
Throttle position sensor VTA2 voltage
2.25 to 5.0 V
ES–111
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Throttle Position Sensor
ECM
VC
VC
Shielded
VTA1
ES
VTA
VTA2
VTA2
E2
E2
E1
A127904E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• If DTCs related to different systems that have terminal E2 as the ground terminal are output
simultaneously, terminal E2 may have an open circuit.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine condition
when malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the
vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or
rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
INSPECT THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR (RESISTANCE)
Component Side
VTA2
VTA1
E2
T3
VC
4 3 2 1
Front View
Throttle Position Sensor Connector
(a) Disconnect the T3 throttle position sensor connector.
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the
throttle position sensor.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1 (VC) - 4 (E2)
1.2 to 3.2 kΩ at 20°C (68°F)
2 (VTA1) - 4 (E2)
1.8 to 10.5 kΩ at 20°C (68°F)
3 (VTA2) - 4 (E2)
1.8 to 10.5 kΩ at 20°C (68°F)
A054410E01
NG
REPLACE THROTTLE W/MOTOR BODY
ASSEMBLY
ES–112
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
OK
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (ECM - THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR)
(a) Disconnect the T3 throttle position sensor connector.
Wire Harness Side
Front View
T3
ES
VC VTA1
VTA2 E2
Throttle Position Sensor Connector
A061997E01
(b) Disconnect the ECM E4 connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E4
VC
E2
VTA
VTA2
ECM Connector
A065743E69
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T3-1 (VC) - E4-18 (VC)
Below 1 Ω
T3-2 (VTA1) - E4-32 (VTA)
Below 1 Ω
T3-3 (VTA2) - E4-31 (VTA2)
Below 1 Ω
T3-4 (E2) - E4-28 (E2)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E4-18 (VC) - E4-28 (E2)
10 kΩ or higher
E4-32 (VTA) - E4-28 (E2)
10 kΩ or higher
E4-31 (VTA2) - E4-28 (E2)
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the ECM connector.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
3
CHECK ECM (VC - E2)
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Measure the voltage between terminals VC and E2 of
the ECM connector.
Standard voltage
E4
VC (+)
E2 (-)
ECM Connector
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E4-18 (VC) - E4-28 (E2)
4.5 to 5.5 V
NG
A124045E05
REPLACE ECM
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–113
OK
REPLACE THROTTLE W/MOTOR BODY ASSEMBLY
ES
ES–114
DTC
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
P0121
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "A"
Circuit Range / Performance Problem
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0120 (see page ES-100).
HINT:
This is the purpose of troubleshooting the throttle position sensor.
ES
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0121
Difference between VTA1 and VTA2 is out of
threshold for 2 seconds
•
Throttle position sensor
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM uses the throttle position sensor to monitor the throttle valve opening angle.
This sensor has two signals, VTA1 and VTA2. VTA1 is used to detect the throttle opening angle and VTA2
is used to detect malfunction in VTA1. There are several checks that the ECM confirms proper operation
of the throttle position sensor and VTA1.
There is a specific voltage difference between VTA1 and VTA2 for each throttle opening angle.
If VTA1 or VTA2 is out of the normal operating range, the ECM interprets this as a fault and will set a DTC.
If VTA1 is within 0.02 V of VTA2, the ECM interprets this as a short circuit in the throttle position sensor
system and will set a DTC.
If the voltage output difference of the VTA1 and VTA2 deviates from the normal operating range, the ECM
interprets this as malfunction of the throttle position sensor. The ECM will turn on the MIL and a DTC is
set.
FAIL-SAFE
If the Electronic Throttle Control System (ETCS) has malfunction, the ECM cuts off current to the throttle
control motor. The throttle control valve returns to a predetermined opening angle (approximately 16°) by
the force of the return spring. The ECM then adjusts the engine output by controlling the fuel injection
(intermittent fuel-cut) and ignition timing in accordance with the accelerator pedal opening angle to enable
the vehicle to continue to drive.
If the accelerator pedal is depressed firmly and slowly, the vehicle can be driven slowly.
If a "pass" condition is detected and then the power switch is turned OFF, the fail-safe operation will stop
and the system will return to normal condition.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0121: Throttle position sensor rationality
Required sensors/components
Throttle position sensor
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
2 seconds
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
None
VTA2 voltage
Less than 4.6 V
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–115
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Less than 0.8 V and more than 1.6 V
Different between VTA1 and VTA2
[VTA1 - (VTA2 x 0.8 to 1.2)]*
*: Corrected by learning value
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine condition when
malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was
running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or rich, and other data
from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
ES
CHECK ANY OTHER DTCS OUTPUT
(a) Connect an intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch on (IG) and turn the tester on.
(c) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(d) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC output)
Proceed To
P0121
A
P0121 and other DTCs
B
B
A
REPLACE THROTTLE W/MOTOR BODY ASSEMBLY
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
ES–116
DTC
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
P0125
Insufficient Coolant Temperature for Closed
Loop Fuel Control
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0115 (see page ES-91).
ES
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0125
Engine coolant temperature hardly changes
for 58 seconds after engine start
(2 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
Cooling system
Engine coolant temperature sensor
Thermostat
P0125
Engine coolant temperature hardly changes
for 109 seconds after engine start
(2 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
Cooling system
Engine coolant temperature sensor
Thermostat
P0125
Engine coolant temperature hardly changes
for 20 minutes after engine start
(2 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
Cooling system
Engine coolant temperature sensor
Thermostat
HINT:
ECT represents engine coolant temperature, and IAT represents intake air temperature.
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The engine coolant temperature (ECT) sensor is used to monitor the temperature of the engine coolant.
The resistance of the sensor varies with the actual engine coolant temperature. The ECM applies voltage
to the sensor and the varying resistance of the sensor causes the signal voltage to vary. The ECM
monitors the ECT signal voltage after engine start-up. If, after sufficient time has passed, the sensor still
reports that the engine is not warm enough for closed-loop fuel control, the ECM interprets this as a fault
in the sensor or cooling system and sets a DTC.
Example:
The engine coolant temperature was 0°C (32°F) at engine start. After driving 5 minutes, the ECT sensor
still indicates that the engine is not warm enough to begin the air-fuel ratio feedback control. The ECM
interprets this as a fault in the sensor or cooling system and will set a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0125
Required sensors/components (Main)
Engine coolant temperature sensor, cooling system, thermostat
Required sensors/components (Related)
Cooling system, thermostat
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
58 seconds (Case 1)
109 seconds (Case 2)
1,200 seconds (Case 3)
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
Case 1
Monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
P0100 - P0103 (MAF meter)
P0110 - P0113 (IAT sensor)
P0115 - P0118 (ECT sensor)
Engine coolant or intake air temperature at engine start
1.66°C (35°F) or more
Case 2
Monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
P0100 - P0103 (MAF meter)
P0110 - P0113 (IAT sensor)
P0115 - P0118 (ECT sensor)
Engine coolant or intake air temperature at engine start
Between -9.5°C (15°F) and 1.66°C (35°F)
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–117
Case 3
Monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
P0100 - P0103 (MAF meter)
P0110 - P0113 (IAT sensor)
P0115 - P0118 (ECT sensor)
Engine coolant or intake air temperature at engine start
Lower than -9.5°C (15°F)
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Engine coolant temperature
Less than 10°C (50°F)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0115 (see page ES-92).
ES
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• If DTCs P0115, P0116, P0117, P0118 and P0125 are output simultaneously, engine coolant
temperature sensor circuit may be open or short. Perform troubleshooting on DTC P0115, P0117 or
P0118 first.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine condition
when malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the
vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or
rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
CHECK OTHER DTC OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P0125)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs using the intelligent tester.
Result
Display (DTC output)
Proceed to
P0125
A
P0125 and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides P0125 are output, perform
troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
A
2
INSPECT THERMOSTAT
(a) Check the valve opening temperature of the thermostat.
OK:
Thermostat valve begins to open at temperature of
80 to 84°C (176 to 183°F)
HINT:
Also check that the valve is completely closed below
temperature shown above.
ES–118
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
NG
REPLACE THERMOSTAT
OK
REPLACE ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
ES
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
ES–119
Coolant Thermostat (Coolant Temperature
Below Thermostat Regulating Temperature)
P0128
DESCRIPTION
HINT:
This is the purpose of detecting the "thermostat" malfunction.
If the engine coolant temperature (ECT) does not reach 75°C (167°F) despite sufficient warm-up time has
elapsed.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0128
Conditions (a), (b) and (c) are met:
(a) Cold start
(b) After sufficient warm-up time has elapsed
(c) Engine coolant temperature is less than
75°C (167°F)
•
•
•
•
Thermostat
Cooling system
Engine coolant temperature sensor
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
5 seconds
Estimated ECT
Threshold
(75°C (167°F))
Indicated Engine Coolant Temperature Reading
ECT
Time
DTC Set (after 2 Driving Cycles)
A082385E13
The ECM estimates the engine coolant temperature (ECT) based on engine starting temperature, engine
loads and engine speed. The ECM then compares the estimated ECT with the actual ECT. When the
estimated ECT reaches 75°C (167°F), the ECM check the actual ECT. If the actual ECT is less than 75°C
(167°F), the ECM will interpret this as a fault in thermostat or the engine cooling system and set a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0128: Thermostat
ES
ES–120
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Required sensors/components
Main:
Engine coolant temperature sensor, engine cooling system,
thermostat
Related:
Intake air temperature sensor, vehicle speed sensor
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
15 minutes
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
P0010 (VVT OCV)
P0011 (VVT system 1 - Advance)
P0012 (VVT system 1 - Retard)
P0031, P0032 (A/F sensor heater - Sensor 1)
P0100 - P0103 (MAF meter)
P0110 - P0113 (IAT sensor)
P0115 - P0118 (ECT sensor)
P0125 (Insufficient ECT for closed loop)
P0171, P0172 (Fuel system)
P0300 - P0304 (Misfire)
P0335 (CKP sensor)
P0340, P0341 (CMP sensor)
P0351-P0354 (Igniter)
P0500 (VSS)
P2196 (A/F sensor - Rationality)
P2A00 (A/F sensor - Slow response)
When one of the following condition 1 or 2 is met
-
1. When all of the following conditions are met
-
ES
Battery voltage
11 V or more
Intake air temperature (at engine start)
-10°C(14°F) or more, and 56°C (132.8°F) or less
Engine coolant temperature (at engine start)
-10°C(14°F) or more, and 56°C (132.8°F) or less
ECT at engine start - IAT at engine start
-15 to 7°C (-27 to 12.6°F)
2. When all of the following conditions are met
-
ECT at engine start - IAT at engine start
Higher than 7°C (12.6°F)
ECT at engine start
56°C (132.8°F) or lower
IAT at engine start
-10°C (14°F) or higher
Accumulated time that vehicle speed is 128 km/h (80 mph) or more
Less than 20 seconds
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
(1) Estimated engine coolant temperature
75°C(167°F) or more
(2) Estimated engine coolant temperature sensor output value
Less than 75°C (167°F)
Duration of both (1) and (2)
5 seconds or more
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Engine coolant temperature sensor output value after warm-up
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to detailed information (see page ES-15).
75°C(167°F) or more
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–121
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine condition when
malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was
running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or rich, and other data
from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
CHECK COOLING SYSTEM
(a) Check that there is a defect in the cooling system which
causes overcooling, such as abnormal radiator fan
operation, modified cooling system and so on.
OK:
There is no modification of cooling system.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE COOLING SYSTEM
OK
2
INSPECT THERMOSTAT
(a) Check the valve opening temperature of the thermostat.
OK:
Thermostat valve begins to open at temperature of
80 to 84°C (176 to 183°F).
HINT:
Also check the valve is completely closed below the
temperature shown above.
NG
OK
REPLACE ECM
REPLACE THERMOSTAT
ES
ES–122
ES
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0136
Oxygen Sensor Circuit Malfunction (Bank 1
Sensor 2)
DTC
P0137
Oxygen Sensor Circuit Low Voltage (Bank 1
Sensor 2)
DTC
P0138
Oxygen Sensor Circuit High Voltage (Bank 1
Sensor 2)
DESCRIPTION
The heated oxygen sensor is used to monitor oxygen concentration in the exhaust gas. For optimum
catalytic converter operation, the air-fuel mixture must be maintained near the ideal "stoichiometric" ratio.
The oxygen sensor output voltage changes suddenly in the vicinity of the stoichiometric ratio. The ECM
adjusts the fuel injection time so that the air-fuel ratio is nearly stoichiometric ratio.
When the air-fuel ratio becomes LEAN, the oxygen concentration in the exhaust gas increases. The
heated oxygen sensor informs the ECM of the LEAN condition (low voltage, i.e. less than 0.45 V).
When the air-fuel ratio is RICHER than the stoichiometric air-fuel ratio, the oxygen will be vanished from
the exhaust gas. The heated oxygen sensor informs the ECM of the RICH condition (high voltage, i.e.
more than 0.45 V).
The heated oxygen sensor includes a heater which heats the zirconia element. The heater is controlled by
the ECM. When the intake air volume is low (the temperature of the exhaust gas is low), current flows to
the heater in order to heat the sensor for the accurate oxygen concentration detection.
Atmospheric Air
Output Voltage
Ideal Air-fuel Mixture
Housing
Solid Electrolyte
(Zirconia Element)
Platinum Electrode
Heater
Coating (Ceramic)
Cover
Richer - Air-fuel Ratio - Leaner
Exhaust Gas
A088111E02
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0136
•
•
•
Problem in heated oxygen sensor voltage
Heated oxygen sensor impedance is too
low
•
•
•
•
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2)
circuit
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2)
Heated oxygen sensor heater (bank 1
sensor 2)
A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
A/F sensor heater
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0137
•
•
•
Heated oxygen sensor impedance is too
high
Problem in heated oxygen sensor output
(low voltage side)
•
•
•
•
P0138
•
Problem in heated oxygen sensor output
(high voltage side)
•
•
•
•
•
ES–123
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2)
circuit
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2)
Heated oxygen sensor heater (bank 1
sensor 2)
A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
A/F sensor heater
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2)
circuit
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2)
Heated oxygen sensor heater (bank 1
sensor 2)
A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
A/F sensor heater
ES
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
Active Air-Fuel Ratio Control
Usually the ECM performs the air-fuel ratio control so that the A/F sensor output indicates a near
stoichiometric air-fuel ratio. This vehicle includes "active air-fuel ratio control" besides the regular air-fuel
ratio control. The ECM performs the "active air-fuel ratio control" to detect deterioration in a catalyst and
the heated oxygen sensor malfunction. (Refer to the diagram below)
The "Active air-fuel ratio control" is performed for approximately 15 to 20 seconds during a vehicle driving
with a warm engine. Under the "active air-fuel ratio control", the air-fuel ratio is forcibly regulated to go
LEAN or RICH by the ECM.
If the ECM detects malfunction, it is recorded in the following DTCs: DTC P0136 (Abnormal Voltage
Output), DTC P0137 (Circuit Open) and P0138 (Circuit Short).
Abnormal Voltage Output of Heated Oxygen Sensor (DTC P0136)
As the ECM is performing the "active air-fuel ratio control", the air-fuel ratio is forcibly regulated to go
RICH or LEAN. If the sensor is not functioning properly, the voltage output variation is smaller.
Under the "active air-fuel ratio control", if the maximum voltage output of the heated oxygen sensor is less
than 0.59 V, or the minimum voltage output is 0.25 V or more, the ECM determines that it is abnormal
voltage output of the sensor (DTC P0136).
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR CIRCUIT MALFUNCTION (P0136: ABNORMAL VOLTAGE)
15 to 20 seconds
Performing
Active air-fuel
ratio control
OFF
Normal
0.59 V
Heated oxygen
sensor voltage
Abnormal
0.25 V
A076837E06
Oxygen Storage Capacity Detection in the Heated Oxygen Sensor Circuit (P0136, P0137 or P0138)
ES–124
ES
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Under "active air-fuel ratio control", the ECM calculates the Oxygen Storage Capacity (OSC)* in the
catalyst by forcibly regulating the air-fuel ratio to go RICH (or LEAN).
If the heated oxygen sensor has an open or short, or the voltage output by the sensor noticeably
decreases, the OSC will indicate extraordinary high value. Even if the ECM attempts to continue
regulating the air-fuel ratio to go RICH (or LEAN), the heated oxygen sensor output does not change.
When the value of OSC calculated by the ECM reaches 1.2 gram under the active air-fuel ratio control,
although the targeted air-fuel ratio is RICH but the voltage output of the heated oxygen sensor is 0.25 V or
less (LEAN), the ECM determines that it is an abnormal low voltage (DTC P0137). Also, the targeted airfuel ratio is LEAN but the voltage output is 0.59 V or more (RICH), it is determined that the voltage output
of the sensor is abnormally high (DTC P0138).
In addition to the OSC detection, if the fluctuation of the sensor voltage output is in a specific narrow
range (more than 0.25 V and less than 0.59) despite the ECM ordering the air-fuel ratio to go RICH or
LEAN while the OSC is above 1.2 gram, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction in the heated oxygen
sensor circuit (DTC P0136).
*Oxygen Storage Capacity (OSC): A catalyst has a capability for storing oxygen. The OSC and the
emission purification capacity of the catalyst are mutually related. The ECM judges if the catalyst has
deteriorated based on the calculated OSC value (see page ES-177).
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR CIRCUIT LOW VOLTAGE (P0137: OPEN)
Active air-fuel
ratio control
Oxygen storage capacity
Target air-fuel ratio
Heated oxygen
sensor voltage
15 to 20 seconds
Performing
OFF
0g
Stoichiometric
1.2 g
RICH
Normal
0.25 V
Abnormal
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR CIRCUIT HIGH VOLTAGE (P0138: SHORT)
Performing
Active air-fuel
ratio control
Oxygen storage capacity
Target air-fuel ratio
Heated oxygen
sensor voltage
OFF
1.2 g
0g
Stoichiometric
LEAN
Abnormal
0.59 V
A092775E01
HINT:
DTC P0138 is also set if the voltage output from the heated oxygen sensor is more than 1.2 V for 10
seconds or more.
Heated oxygen sensor impedance
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–125
Interrelation between temperature of
element and impedance:
(Ω)
15,000
DTC Detection Area
1,000
100
10
5
300 400 500 600 700 800
(572) (752) (932)(1,112)(1,292)(1,472)
°C (°F)
A076841E05
During normal feedback control of the air-fuel ratio, there are small variations in the exhaust gas oxygen
concentration. In order to continuously monitor the slight variation of the signal from the oxygen sensor
while the engine is running, the impedance* of the sensor is measured by the ECM. The ECM detects that
there is malfunction in the sensor when the measured impedance deviates from the standard range.
*: The effective resistance in an alternating current electrical circuit.
HINT:
• The impedance can not be measured with an ohmmeter.
• DTC P0136 indicates deterioration of the heated oxygen sensor. The ECM sets the DTC by calculating
the impedance of the sensor after the typical enabling conditions are satisfied (2 driving-cycles).
• DTC P0137 indicates an open or short circuit in the heated oxygen sensor system (2 driving-cycles).
The ECM sets this DTC when the impedance of the sensor exceeds the threshold 15 kΩ.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Case 1: Output voltage (Active A/F control method)
Related DTCs
P0136
Required sensors/components (main)
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2)
Required sensors/components (related)
A/F sensor
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
20 seconds
MIL operation
1 driving cycles
Sequence of operation
None
Case 2: Low impedance
Related DTCs
P0136
Required sensors/components (main)
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2)
Required sensors/components (related)
None
Frequency of operation
Continuously
Duration
30 seconds
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of operation
None
Case 3: High impedance
Related DTCs
P0137
Required sensors/components (main)
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2)
Required sensors/components (related)
None
Frequency of operation
Continuously
Duration
155 seconds
ES
ES–126
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of operation
None
Case 4: Low voltage (Active A/F control method)
ES
Related DTCs
P0137
Required sensors/components (main)
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2)
Required sensors/components (related)
A/F sensor
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
20 seconds
MIL operation
1 driving cycles
Sequence of operation
None
Case 5: High voltage (Active A/F control method)
Related DTCs
P0138
Required sensors/components (main)
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2)
Required sensors/components (related)
A/F sensor
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
20 seconds
MIL operation
1 driving cycles
Sequence of operation
None
Case 6: High voltage
Related DTCs
P0138
Required sensors/components (main)
Heated oxygen sensor (bank 1 sensor 2)
Required sensors/components (related)
None
Frequency of operation
Continuously
Duration
10 seconds
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
Monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
P0031, P0032 (A/F sensor heater - Sensor 1)
P0037, P0038 (O2 sensor heater - Sensor 2)
P0100 - P0103 (MAF meter)
P0110 - P0113 (IAT sensor)
P0115 - P0118 (ECT sensor)
P0120 - P0223, P2135 (TP sensor)
P0125 (Insufficient ECT for closed loop)
P0171, P0172 (Fuel system)
P0300 - P0304 (Misfire)
P0335 (CKP sensor)
P0340, P0341 (CMP sensor)
P0442 - P0456 (EVAP system)
P0500 (VSS)
P2196 (A/F sensor - Rationality)
P2A00 (A/F sensor - Slow response)
Case 1: Output voltage (Active A/F control method)
Active A/F control
Executing
Active A/F control begins when the following conditions are met
-
Battery voltage
11.5 V or higher
Engine coolant temperature
75°C (167°F) or higher
Idle
OFF
Engine speed
Less than 3,200 rpm
A/F sensor status
Activated
Duration after fuel-cut: OFF
10 seconds or more
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Engine load
ES–127
10 to 70%
Case 2: Low impedance
Estimated sensor temperature
Lower than 750°C (1,382°F)
Case 3: High impedance
Estimated sensor temperature
450°C (842°F) or higher
Intake air amount
More than 0 g/sec.
Case 4: Low voltage (Active A/F control method)
Same as case 1
Case 5: High voltage (Active A/F control method)
Same as case 1
ES
Case 6: High voltage
Engine
Running
Battery voltage
10.5 V or higher
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Case 1: Output voltage (Active A/F control method)
Either of the following conditions 1 or 2 set
-
1. All of following conditions (a), (b) and (c) set
-
(a) Commanded air-fuel ratio
14.3 or less
(b) Sensor voltage
0.25 to 0.59 V
(c) OSC (Oxygen Storage Capacity of catalyst)
1.2 g or more
2. All of following conditions (d), (e) and (f) set
-
(d) Commanded air-fuel ratio
14.9 or more
(e) Rear HO2S voltage
0.25 to 0.59 V
(f) OSC (oxygen storage capacity of catalyst)
1.2 g or more
Case 2: Low impedance
Sensor impedance
Less than 5 Ω
Case 3: High impedance
Sensor impedance
15,000 Ω or higher
Case 4: Low voltage (Active A/F control method)
All of following conditions (a), (b) and (c) set
-
(a) Commanded air-fuel ratio
14.3 or less
(b) Sensor voltage
Less than 0.25 V
(c) OSC (Oxygen Storage Capacity of catalyst)
1.2 g or more
Case 5: High voltage (Active A/F control method)
All of following conditions (d), (e) and (f) set
-
(d) Commanded air-fuel ratio
14.9 or more
(e) Sensor voltage
More than 0.59 V
(f) OSC (Oxygen Storage Capacity of catalyst)
1.2 g or more
Case 6: High voltage
Sensor voltage
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to detailed information (see page ES-15).
1.2 V or more
ES–128
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
MREL
Integration Relay
Heated Oxygen Sensor
(Bank 1 Sensor 2)
ES
EFI M
EFI
+B
HT1B
HT
Shielded
E
OX
OX1B
P/I
E2
MAIN
E1
A127905E01
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
1. For DTC P0136 and P0137
HINT:
Performing this confirmation pattern will activate the DTC detection (P0136) of the ECM. This is very
useful for verifying the completion of a repair.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–129
88 km/h (55 mph)
(under 3,200 rpm)
70 km/h (44 mph)
(over 1,100 rpm)
Warm up time
Idling
Power Switch OFF
(Idle speed)
ES
5 to 10 minutes
A092806E04
(a) Clear the DTCs (see page ES-29).
(b) Put the engine in inspection mode (see page ES-1).
(c) Start the engine and warm it up with all the accessory switches OFF.
(d) Deactivate the inspection mode and drive the vehicle at 70 to 112 km/h (44 to 70 mph) for 5 to 10
minutes.
(e) Read DTCs.
NOTICE:
• If the conditions in this test are not strictly followed, no malfunction will be detected. If you do
not have the intelligent tester, turn the power switch OFF after performing steps (c) and (e), then
perform step (d) again.
• Do not drive the vehicle without deactivating inspection mode, otherwise damaging the
transaxle may result.
2. For DTC P0138
HINT:
Performing this confirmation pattern will activate the DTC detection (P0138) of the ECM. This is very
useful for verifying the completion of a repair.
Engine
Speed
Idling
(b)
(a)
1 minute
Time
A076853E01
(a) Clear the DTCs (see page ES-29).
(b) Put the engine in inspection mode (see page ES-1).
(c) Start the engine and let the engine idle for 1 minute.
(e) Read DTCs.
NOTICE:
If the conditions in this test are not strictly followed, no malfunction will be detected.
ES–130
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine condition when
malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was
running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or rich, and other data
from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
CHECK OTHER DTC OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P0136, P0137 AND/OR P0138)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result
ES
Display (DTC output)
Proceed to
P0136, P0137 and/or P0138
A
P0136, P0137 and/or P0138, and
other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides P0136, P0137 and/or P0138
are output, perform troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
A
2
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (A/F CONTROL)
HINT:
Malfunctioning areas can be found by performing the ACTIVE
TEST / A/F CONTROL operation. The A/F CONTROL
operation can determine if the A/F sensor, heated oxygen
sensor or other potential trouble area are malfunctioning or
not.
(a) Perform A/F CONTROL operation using the intelligent
tester.
HINT:
The A/F CONTROL operation lowers the injection
volume 12.5% or increases the injection volume 25%.
(1) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(3) Put the engine in inspection mode (see page ES-1).
(4) Warm up the engine by running the engine at 2,500
rpm, depressing the accelerator pedal more than
60% for approximately 90 seconds.
(5) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / A/F
CONTROL.
(6) Perform the A/F CONTROL operation with the
engine in an idle condition (press the right or left
button).
ES–131
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Result:
A/F sensor reacts in accordance with increase and
decrease of injection volume:
+25% → rich output: Less than 3.0 V
-12.5% → lean output: More than 3.35 V
Heated oxygen sensor reacts in accordance with
increase and decrease of injection volume:
+25% → rich output: More than 0.55 V
-12.5% → lean output: Less than 0.4 V
NOTICE:
The A/F sensor output has a few seconds of delay and
the heated oxygen sensor output has about 20 seconds
of delay at maximum.
Case
A/F Sensor (Sensor 1) Output Voltage
Main Suspected
Trouble Area
HO2 Sensor (Sensor 2) Output Voltage
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
Output Voltage
More than 0.55 V
Less than 0.4 V
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Output Voltage
More than 0.55 V
Less than 0.4 V
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
-
1
2
3
4
•
•
•
A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
A/F sensor circuit
•
•
•
HO2 sensor
HO2 sensor heater
HO2 sensor circuit
•
•
•
Fuel Injector
Fuel pressure
Gas leakage from
exhaust system (Airfuel ratio extremely
or lean rich)
The following A/F CONTROL procedure enables the
technician to check and graph the voltage output of both A/F
sensor and heated oxygen sensor.
To display the graph, enter ACTIVE TEST/ A/F CONTROL /
USER DATA, select "AFS B1S1 and O2S B1S2" by pressing
the "YES" button followed by the "ENTER" button and then
the "F4" button.
• A high A/F sensor voltage could be caused by a RICH airfuel mixture. Check the conditions that would cause the
engine to run with the RICH air-fuel mixture.
• A low A/F sensor voltage could be caused by a LEAN airfuel mixture. Check the conditions that would cause the
engine to run with the LEAN air-fuel mixture.
ES
ES–132
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Result
Output voltage of A/F sensor
Output voltage of heated oxygen sensor
Proceed to
OK
OK
A
NG
OK
B
OK
NG
C
NG
NG
D
B
GO TO DTC P2238
C
D
ES
Go to step 5
GO TO DTC P0171
A
3
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
HINT:
Clear all DTCs prior to performing the confirmation driving
pattern.
GO
4
READ OUTPUT DTCS (DTC P0136, P0137 AND/OR P0138 ARE OUTPUT AGAIN)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC output)
Proceed to
P0136, P0137 and/or P0138
A
P0136, P0137 and/or P0138, and
other DTCs
B
B
A
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
REPLACE HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
5
ES–133
INSPECT HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (HEATER RESISTANCE)
(a) Disconnect the H13 heated oxygen sensor connector.
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the
heated oxygen sensor connector.
Standard resistance
Component Side
+B
HT
2
H13
4
1
Front View
3
OX
E
Heated Oxygen Sensor
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
H13-1 (HT) - H13-2 (+B)
11 to 16 Ωat 20°C (68°F)
H13-1 (HT) - H13-4 (E)
10 kΩ or higher
(c) Reconnect the heated oxygen sensor connector.
A062378E36
NG
REPLACE HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
OK
6
INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY (EFI M RELAY)
Integration Relay
Connector
IGCT
HORN
AM2
IG2
EFI
EFI M
Relay Detail
6
7
8
1
Specified Condition
3K-1 - 3I-8
10 kΩ or higher
3K-1 - 3I-8
Below 1 Ω
(Apply battery voltage to terminals
3I-6 and 3I-7)
NG
3I
3I
3I
3K
A082812E01
OK
Tester Connection
(c) Reinstall the integration relay.
3I
3I
3I
3K
8
7
6
1
(a) Remove the integration relay from the engine room relay
block.
(b) Inspect the EFI M relay.
Standard resistance
REPLACE INTEGRATION RELAY
ES
ES–134
7
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the H13 heated oxygen sensor connector.
Wire Harness Side
Heated Oxygen Sensor Connector
HT
H13
OX
Front View
ES
A079118E07
(b) Disconnect the E6 ECM connectors.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E6
Tester Connection
HT1B
OX1B
ECM Connector
Specified Condition
H13-1 (HT) - E6-6 (HT1B)
Below 1 Ω
H13-3 (OX) - E6-22 (OX1B)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
A065748E30
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
H13-1 (HT) or E6-6 (HT1B) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
H13-3 (OX) or E6-22 (OX1B) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the heated oxygen sensor connector.
(e) Reconnect the ECM connector.
Reference (Bank 1 Sensor 2 System Diagram)
EFI M
From
Battery
ECM
Heated Oxygen Sensor
HT1B
Heater
EFI
OX1B
Sensor
Ground
Duty
Control
Ground
A073886E02
NG
OK
REPLACE HATED OXYGEN SENSOR
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0171
System Too Lean (Fuel Trim)
DTC
P0172
System Too Rich (Bank 1)
ES–135
DESCRIPTION
The fuel trim is related to the feedback compensation value, not to the basic injection time. The fuel trim
includes the short-term fuel trim and the long-term fuel trim.
The short-term fuel trim is the short-term fuel compensation used to maintain the air-fuel ratio at
stoichiometric air-fuel ratio. The signal from the A/F sensor indicates whether the air-fuel ratio is RICH or
LEAN compared to the stoichiometric air-fuel ratio. This variance triggers a reduction in the fuel volume if
the air-fuel ratio is RICH, and an increase in the fuel volume if it is LEAN.
The long-term fuel trim is the overall fuel compensation carried out in long-term to compensate for a
continual deviation of the short-term fuel trim from the central value, due to individual engine differences,
wear overtime and changes in the operating environment.
If both the short-term fuel trim and the long-term fuel trim are LEAN or RICH beyond a certain value, it is
detected as a malfunction and the MIL is illuminated and DTC is set.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0171
When air-fuel ratio feedback is stable after
warming up engine, fuel trim is considerably
in error on LEAN side
(2 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
P0172
When air-fuel ratio feedback is stable after
warming up engine, fuel trim is considerably
in error on RICH side
(2 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Air induction system
Injector blockage
Mass air flow meter
Engine coolant temperature sensor
Fuel pressure
Gas leakage in exhaust system
Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 1,
sensor 1) circuit
A/F sensor (bank 1, sensor 1)
A/F sensor heater (bank 1, sensor 1)
EFI M relay
PCV valve and hose
PCV hose connection
ECM
Injector leak, blockage
Mass air flow meter
Engine coolant temperature sensor
Ignition system
Fuel pressure
Gas leakage in exhaust system
Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 1,
sensor 1) circuit
A/F sensor (bank 1, sensor 1)
A/F sensor heater
EFI M relay
ECM
HINT:
• When DTC P0171 is recorded, the actual air-fuel ratio is on the LEAN side. When DTC P0172 is
recorded, the actual air-fuel ratio is on the RICH side.
• If the vehicle runs out of fuel, the air-fuel ratio is LEAN and DTC P0171 may be recorded. The MIL then
illuminates.
• If the total of the short-term fuel trim value and long-term fuel trim value is between +33% and -30%
(engine coolant temperature is more than 75°C (167°F)), the system is functioning normally.
ES
ES–136
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
+35%: Threshold at LEAN
1.35
ES
Fuel compensation
amount
1.0
-30%: Threshold at RICH
0.65
A082386E27
Under closed-loop fuel control, fuel injection amount that deviates from the ECM's estimated fuel amount
will cause a change in the long-term fuel trim compensation value. This long-term fuel trim is adjusted
when there are persistent deviations in the short-term fuel trim values. And the deviation from the
simulated fuel injection amount by the ECM affects a smoothed fuel trim learning value. The smoothed
fuel trim learning value is the combination of smoothed short-term fuel trim (fuel feedback compensation
value) and smoothed long-term fuel trim (learning value of the air-fuel ratio). When the smoothed fuel trim
learning value exceeds the DTC threshold, the ECM interprets this as a fault in the fuel system and sets a
DTC.
Example:
The smoothed fuel trim leaning value is more than +33% or less than -30%.
The ECM interprets this as a failure in the fuel system.
DTC P0171 indicates that the air-fuel mixture is extremely LEAN, and P0172 indicates extremely RICH.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0171: Fuel system lean (bank 1)
P0172: Fuel system rich (bank 1)
Required sensors/components
Main:
A/F sensor
Related:
Engine coolant temperature sensor, mass air flow meter, crankshaft
position sensor
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
10 seconds
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of operation
None
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–137
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
P0010 (VVT OCV)
P0011 (VVT system 1 - Advance)
P0012 (VVT system 1 - Retard)
P0031, P0032 (A/F sensor heater - Sensor 1)
P0100 - P0103 (MAF meter)
P0115 - P0118 (ECT sensor)
P0120 - P0223, P2135 (TP sensor)
P0125 (Insufficient ECT for closed loop)
P0335 (CKP sensor)
P0340, P0341 (CMP sensor)
P0351-P0354 (Igniter)
P0500 (VSS)
Battery voltage
11 V or more
Fuel system: Closed-loop
More than 13 seconds
One of the following condition is met:
(a) or (b)
(a) Engine speed
Less than 1,100 rpm
(b) Intake air amount per revolution
0.22 g/rev or more
Warm-up condition enables air-fuel ratio learning control
Conditions are met
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Following condition is continued for 3 seconds
(a) or (b)
(a) Smoothed fuel trim learning value (lean)
33% or more
(b) Smoothed fuel trim learning value (rich)
-30% or less
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P2195 (see page ES-347).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Malfunctioning areas can be found by performing the ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL operation. The A/F
CONTROL operation can determine if the A/F sensor, heated oxygen sensor or other potential trouble
area are malfunctioning or not.
(a) Perform the ACTIVE TEST A/F CONTROL operation.
HINT:
The A/F CONTROL operation lowers the injection volume 12.5% or increases the injection volume 25%.
(1) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(3) Put the engine in inspection mode (see page ES-1).
(4) Warm up the engine by running the engine at 2,500 rpm, depressing the accelerator pedal more than
60% for approximately 90 seconds.
(5) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL.
(6) Perform the A/F CONTROL operation with the engine in an idle condition (press the right or left
button).
Result:
A/F sensor reacts in accordance with increase and decrease of injection volume:
+25% → rich output: Less than 3.0 V
-12.5% → lean output: More than 3.35 V
Heated oxygen sensor reacts in accordance with increase and decrease of injection volume:
+25% → rich output: More than 0.55 V
-12.5% → lean output: Less than 0.4 V
ES
ES–138
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
NOTICE:
The A/F sensor output has a few seconds of delay and the heated oxygen sensor output has about
20 seconds of delay at maximum.
Case
A/F Sensor (Sensor 1) Output Voltage
Main Suspected
Trouble Area
HO2 Sensor (Sensor 2) Output Voltage
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
Output Voltage
More than 0.55 V
Less than 0.4 V
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Output Voltage
More than 0.55 V
Less than 0.4 V
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
-
1
ES
2
3
4
•
•
•
A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
A/F sensor circuit
•
•
•
HO2 sensor
HO2 sensor heater
HO2 sensor circuit
•
•
•
Fuel Injector
Fuel pressure
Gas leakage from
exhaust system (Airfuel ratio extremely
or lean rich)
The following A/F CONTROL procedure enables the technician to check and graph the voltage output of
both A/F sensor and heated oxygen sensor.
To display the graph, enter ACTIVE TEST/ A/F CONTROL/USER DATA, select "AFS B1S1 and O2S
B1S2" by pressing the "YES" button followed by the "ENTER" button and then the "F4" button.
HINT:
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine condition
when malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the
vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or
rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
• A high A/F sensor voltage could be caused by a RICH air-fuel mixture. Check the conditions that would
cause the engine to run with the RICH air-fuel mixture.
• A low A/F sensor voltage could be caused by a LEAN air-fuel mixture. Check the conditions that would
cause the engine to run with the LEAN air-fuel mixture.
1
CHECK AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
(a) Check for vacuum leaks in the air induction system.
OK:
No vacuum leakage.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE AIR INDUCTION
SYSTEM
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–139
OK
2
CHECK CONNECTION OF PCV HOSE
OK:
PCV hose is connected correctly and PCV hose is not
damaged.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE PCV HOSE
OK
3
INSPECT FUEL INJECTOR ASSEMBLY (INJECTION AND VOLUME)
OK:
Injection volume: 36 to 46 cm3 (2.1 to 2.8 cu in.) per 15
seconds.
NG
REPLACE FUEL INJECTOR ASSEMBLY
OK
4
INSPECT MASS AIR FLOW METER
Air
E2
VG
THA
+B
E2G
5 4 3 2 1
30
20
0.1
Specified Condition
3 (VG) - 2 (E2G)
Sensor output voltage fluctuates
between 0.3 V and 4.8 V
(c) Inspect the resistance.
(1) Measure the resistance between the terminals of
the mass air flow meter.
Standard resistance
Acceptable
1
0.5
0.3
0.2
Tester Connection
Resistance kΩ
10
5
3
2
(a) Remove the mass air flow meter.
(b) Inspect the output voltage.
(1) Apply battery voltage across terminals +B and E2G.
(2) Connect the positive (+) tester probe to terminal VG,
and negative (-) tester probe to terminal E2G.
(3) Blow air into the mass air flow meter, and check that
the voltage fluctuates.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
4 (THA) - 5 (E2)
13.6 to 18.4 kΩ at -20°C (-4°F)
4 (THA) - 5 (E2)
2.21 to 2.69 kΩ at 20°C (68°F)
4 (THA) - 5 (E2)
0.49 to 0.67 kΩ at 60°C (140°F)
(d) Reinstall the mass air flow meter.
Temperature °C (°F)
NG
20 40 60 80 100
-20
0
(-4) (32) (68) (104) (140) (176) (212)
A060548E05
REPLACE MASS AIR FLOW METER
ES
ES–140
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
OK
5
INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR (RESISTANCE)
(a) Remove the engine coolant temperature sensor.
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the
engine coolant temperature sensor.
Standard resistance
Ohmmeter
Resistance
kΩ
ES
Acceptable
Temperature °C (°F)
A081700E08
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1-2
2 to 3 kΩ at 20°C (68°F)
1-2
0.2 to 0.4 kΩ at 80°C (176°F)
NOTICE:
When checking the engine coolant temperature sensor in
water, be careful not to allow water to contact the
terminals. After checking, dry the sensor.
HINT:
Alternate procedure: Connect an ohmmeter to the installed
engine coolant temperature sensor and read the resistance.
Use an infrared thermometer to measure the engine
temperature in the immediate vicinity of the sensor. Compare
these values to the resistance/temperature graph. Change
the engine temperature (warm up or allow to cool down) and
repeat the test.
(c) Reinstall the engine coolant temperature sensor.
NG
REPLACE ENGINE COOLANT
TEMPERATURE SENSOR
OK
6
CHECK SPARK AND IGNITION
OK:
Sparks occurs.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE IGNITION SYSTEM
COMPONENTS
OK
7
CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
OK:
Fuel pressure: 304 to 343 kPa (3.1 to 3.5 kgf/cm2, 44 to
50 psi)
NG
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE FUEL SYSTEM
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
8
ES–141
CHECK FOR EXHAUST GAS LEAKAGE
OK:
No gas leak.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE EXHAUST GAS
LEAKAGE POINT
OK
9
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (OUTPUT VOLTAGE OF AIR FUEL RATIO
SENSOR [BANK 1 SENSOR 1])
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC 3.
(b) Put the engine in inspection mode (see page ES-1).
(c) Warm up the A/F sensors (bank 1 sensor 1) by running
the engine at 2,500 rpm with the accelerator pedal
depressed more than 60 % for approximately 90
seconds.
(d) Read A/F sensor voltage output on the intelligent tester.
(e) Enter the following menus: ENHANCED OBD II /
SNAPSHOT / MANUAL SNAPSHOT / USER DATA.
(f) Select "AFS B1 S1/ENGINE SPD" and press button
"YES".
(g) Monitor the A/F sensor voltage carefully.
(h) Check the A/F sensor voltage output under the following
conditions:
(1) Put the engine in inspection mode and allow the
engine to idle for 30 seconds.
(2) Put the engine in inspection mode and running the
engine at 2,500 rpm with the accelerator pedal
depressed more than 60% (where engine RPM is
not suddenly changed).
(3) Deactivate the inspection mode and drive the
vehicle with shift position "B" range.
(4) Accelerate the vehicle to 70 km/h (44 mph) and
quickly release the accelerator pedal so that the
throttle valve is fully closed.
CAUTION:
• Strictly observe of posted speed limits, traffic laws,
and road conditions when performing these drive
patterns.
• Do not drive the vehicle without deactivating
inspection mode, otherwise damaging the transaxle
may result.
OK:
Condition (1) and (2)
Voltage changes in the vicinity of 3.3 V (between
approximately 3.1 to 3.5 V) as shown in the illustration.
Condition (4)
A/F sensor voltage increases to 3.8 V or more during
engine deceleration (when fuel cut) as shown in the
illustration.
ES
ES–142
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Malfunction Condition
Normal Condition
(4) Approximately 4,000 rpm
(2) 2,500 rpm
(2) 2,500 rpm
(1) Idle
(1) Idle
(1) Idle
(1) Idle
Engine
RPM
ES
(4) Approximately
4,000 rpm
Engine
RPM
"Condition (3)"
3.8 V or More
A/F Sensor
Voltage
A/F Sensor
Voltage
Fuel Cut
Fuel Cut
"Condition (1), (2)"
Change in the vicinity of approximately 3.3 V
When A/F sensor circuit is malfunctioning,
voltage output does not change
A072304E10
HINT:
• Whenever the output voltage of the A/F sensor remains at
approximately 3.3 V (see diagram Malfunction Condition)
under any condition as well as the above conditions, the A/
F sensor may have an open-circuit. (This will happen also
when the A/F sensor heater has an open-circuit.)
• Whenever the output voltage of the A/F sensor remains at
a certain value of approximately 3.8 V or more, or 2.8 V or
less (see diagram Malfunction Condition) under any
condition as well as the above conditions, the A/F sensor
may have a short-circuit.
• The ECM will stop fuel injection (fuel cut) during engine
deceleration. This will cause a LEAN condition and should
result in a momentary increase in A/F sensor voltage
output.
• The ECM must establish a closed throttle position learned
value to perform fuel cut. If the battery terminal was
reconnected, the vehicle must be driven over 10 mph to
allow the ECM to learn the closed throttle position.
• When the vehicle is driven:
The output voltage of the A/F sensor may be below 2.8 V
during fuel enrichment. For the vehicle, this translates to a
sudden increase in speed with the accelerator pedal fully
depressed when trying to overtake another vehicle. The A/
F sensor is functioning normally.
• The A/F sensor is a current output element, and therefore
the current is converted into voltage inside the ECM. If
measuring voltage at connectors of A/F sensor or ECM,
you will observe a constant voltage.
OK
Go to step 17
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–143
NG
10
INSPECT AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR (HEATER RESISTANCE)
(a) Disconnect the A5 A/F sensor connector.
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the A/F
sensor.
Standard resistance
Component Side
A/F Sensor
HT
A5
+B
AF-
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1 (HT) - 2 (+B)
1.8 to 3.4 Ωat 20°C (68°F)
(c) Reconnect the A/F sensor connector.
AF+
A085152E55
NG
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
OK
11
INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY (EFI M RELAY)
Integration Relay
Connector
IGCT
HORN
AM2
IG2
EFI
EFI M
Relay Detail
6
7
8
1
Specified Condition
3K-1 - 3I-8
10 kΩ or higher
3K-1 - 3I-8
Below 1 Ω
(Apply battery voltage to terminals
3I-6 and 3I-7)
NG
3I
3I
3I
3K
A082812E01
OK
Tester Connection
(c) Reinstall the integration relay.
3I
3I
3I
3K
8
7
6
1
(a) Remove the integration relay from the engine room relay
block.
(b) Inspect the EFI M relay.
Standard resistance
REPLACE INTEGRATION RELAY
ES
ES–144
12
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (A/F SENSOR - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the A5 A/F sensor connector.
Wire Harness Side
A5 Sensor 1
HT
+B
AF+
ES
AF-
Heated Oxygen Sensor Connector
A085153E08
(b) Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E5
HA1A
A1A-
A1A+
ECM Connector
A065745E71
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A5-3 (AF+) - E5-23 (A1A+)
Below 1 Ω
A5-4 (AF-) - E5-22 (A1A-)
Below 1 Ω
A5-1 (HT) - E5-7 (HA1A)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A5-3 (AF+) or E5-23 (A1A+) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
A5-4 (AF-) or E5-22 (A1A-) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
A5-1 (HT) or E5-7 (HA1A) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the A/F sensor connector.
(e) Reconnect the ECM connector.
Reference (Bank 1 Sensor 1 System Diagram)
From
Battery
EFI
EFI M
ECM
A/F Sensor
HA1A
Heater
A1A+
Sensor
A1A-
Duty
Control
MREL
B062793E19
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–145
OK
13
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
GO
14
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
Vehicle Speed
Idling
ES
(e)
70 to 120 km/h
(44 to 75 mph)
(d)
Power Switch OFF
(a), (b), (c)
2 minutes
5 to 10 minutes
Time
A079199E55
(a) Clear the DTCs (see page ES-29).
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Switch the ECM from normal mode to check mode using
the intelligent tester (see page ES-32).
(d) Put the engine in inspection mode, and start the engine
and warm it up with all the accessory switches OFF.
(e) Deactivate inspection mode and drive the vehicle at 70
to 120 km/h (44 to 75 mph) and engine speed of 1,100 to
3,200 rpm for 5 to 10 minutes.
HINT:
If malfunction exists, the MIL will be illuminated during step
(e).
NOTICE:
• If the conditions in this test are not strictly followed,
no malfunction will be detected. If you do not have an
intelligent tester, turn the power switch OFF after
performing steps (d) and (e), then perform step (e)
again.
• Do not drive the vehicle without deactivating
inspection mode, otherwise damaging the transaxle
may result.
GO
15
READ OUTPUT DTCS (SEE IF DTC P0171 AND/OR P0172 ARE OUTPUT AGAIN)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
ES–146
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs using the intelligent tester.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
No output
A
P0171 and/or P0172
B
B
ES
REPLACE ECM AND PERFORM
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
A
16
CONFIRM IF VEHICLE HAS RUN OUT OF FUEL IN PAST
NO
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
YES
DTCS ARE CAUSED BY RUNNING OUT OF FUEL (DTCS P0171 AND/OR P0172)
17
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
HINT:
Clear all DTCs prior to performing the confirmation driving
pattern.
GO
18
READ OUTPUT DTCS (SEE IF DTC P0171 AND/OR P0172 ARE OUTPUT AGAIN)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs using the intelligent tester.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
No output
A
P0171 and/or P0172
B
B
A
Proceed to
Go to step 22
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
19
ES–147
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
GO
20
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
HINT:
Clear all DTCs prior to performing the confirmation driving
pattern.
GO
21
ES
READ OUTPUT DTCS (SEE IF DTC P0171 AND/OR P0172 ARE OUTPUT AGAIN)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs using the intelligent tester.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
No output
A
P0171 and/or P0172
B
B
REPLACE ECM AND PERFORM
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
A
22
CONFIRM IF VEHICLE HAS RUN OUT OF FUEL IN PAST
NO
YES
DTCS ARE CAUSED BY RUNNING OUT OF FUEL
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
ES–148
ES
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0300
Random / Multiple Cylinder Misfire Detected
DTC
P0301
Cylinder 1 Misfire Detected
DTC
P0302
Cylinder 2 Misfire Detected
DTC
P0303
Cylinder 3 Misfire Detected
DTC
P0304
Cylinder 4 Misfire Detected
DESCRIPTION
When a misfire occurs in the engine, hydrocarbons (HC) enter the exhaust gas in high concentrations. If
this HC concentration is high enough, there could be an increase in exhaust emissions levels. High
concentrations of HC can also cause to temperature of the catalyst to increase, possibly damaging the
catalyst. To prevent this increase in emissions and limit the possibility of thermal damage, the ECM
monitors the misfire rate. When the temperature of the catalyst reaches a point of thermal degradation,
the ECM will blink the MIL. For monitoring misfire, the ECM uses both the camshaft position sensor and
the crankshaft position sensor. The camshaft position sensor is used to identify misfiring cylinders and the
crankshaft position sensor is used to measure variations in the crankshaft rotation speed. The misfire
counter increments when crankshaft rotation speed variations exceed threshold values.
If the misfiring rate exceeds the threshold value and could cause emissions deterioration, the ECM
illuminates the MIL.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0300
Misfiring of random cylinders is detected
during any particular 200 or 1,000 revolutions
1 trip detection logic: MIL blinks
2 trip detection logic: MIL illuminates
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Open or short in engine wire harness
Connector connection
Vacuum hose connection
Ignition system
Injector
Fuel pressure
Mass air flow meter
Engine coolant temperature sensor
Compression pressure
Valve clearance
Valve timing
PCV hose connection
PCV hose
ECM
P0301
P0302
P0303
P0304
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Open or short in engine wire harness
Connector connection
Vacuum hose connection
Ignition system
Injector
Fuel pressure
Mass air flow meter
Engine coolant temperature sensor
Compression pressure
Valve clearance
Valve timing
PCV hose connection
PCV hose
ECM
•
For any particular 200 revolutions of
engine, misfiring is detected which can
cause catalyst overheating (This causes
MIL to blink)
For any particular 1,000 revolutions of
engine, misfiring is detected which
causes a deterioration in emissions (2 trip
detection logic)
NOTICE:
When several codes for a misfiring cylinder are recorded repeatedly but no random misfire code is
recorded, it indicates that the misfires have been detected and recorded at different times.
Reference: Inspection using oscilloscope
ES–149
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
With the engine idling, check the waveform between terminals #10 to #40 and E01 of the ECM
connectors.
HINT:
The correct waveform is as shown.
Injector Signal Waveform
Magnification
20 V/DIV.
20 V/DIV.
ES
GND
GND
100 msec./DIV. (Idling)
Injection Duration
1 msec./DIV. (Idling)
A078423E05
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
Camshaft position sensor
Crankshaft position sensor
(34 teen)
ECM
A083872E02
The ECM illuminates the MIL (2 trip detection logic) if:
• The percent misfire exceeds the specified limit per 1,000 engine revolutions. One occurrence of
excessive misfire during engine start will set the MIL. After engine start, four occurrences of excessive
misfire set the MIL.
The ECM blinks the MIL (immediately) if:
• The threshold for percent of misfire causing catalyst damage is reached 1 time in 200 engine
revolutions at a high rpm, and 3 times in 200 engine revolutions at a normal rpm.
• The threshold for percent of misfire causing catalyst damage is reached.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0300: Random/Multiple cylinder misfire detected
P0301: Cylinder 1 misfire detected
P0302: Cylinder 2 misfire detected
P0303: Cylinder 3 misfire detected
P0304: Cylinder 4 misfire detected
ES–150
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Required sensors/components
Main:
Camshaft position sensor, crankshaft position sensor
Related:
Engine coolant temperature sensor, intake air temperature sensor,
throttle position sensor
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
Every 1,000 revolutions:
Every 200 revolutions:
MIL operation
2 driving cycles: MIL ON
Immediately: MIL blinking (catalyst deteriorating)
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
ES
Monitor runs whenever following DTCs not present
P0100 - P0103 (MAF meter)
P0110 - P0113 (IAT sensor)
P0115 - P0118 (ECT sensor)
P0120 - P0223, P2135 (TP sensor)
P0125 (Insufficient ECT for closed loop)
P0325 - P0328 (knock sensor)
P0335 (CKP sensor)
P0340 (CMP sensor)
P0500 (VSS)
Battery voltage
8 V or more
Throttle position learning
Completed
VVT system
Not operated by scan tool
Engine RPM
850 to 5,300 rpm
Both of following conditions 1 and 2 met
-
1. Engine coolant temperature (ECT)
-10°C (14°F) or more
2. Either of following conditions (a) or (b) met
-
(a) ECT at engine start
More than -7°C (19°F)
(b) ECT
More than 20°C (68°F)
Fuel cut
OFF
Monitor period of emission-related-misfire:
First 1,000 revolution after engine start, or check mode
Crankshaft 1,000 revolutions
Except above
Crankshaft 1,000 revolutions x 4
Monitor period of catalyst-damaged-misfire (MIL blinks):
All of following conditions 1, 2 and 3 met
Crankshaft 200 revolutions x 3
1. Driving cycles
1st
2. Check mode
OFF
3. Engine RPM
Less than 3,400 rpm
Except above
Crankshaft 200 revolutions
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Emission - related - misfire
Misfire rate
2 % or more
Catalyst - damage - misfire (MIL blinks)
Number of misfire per 200 revolution
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to detailed information (see page ES-15).
108 or more (varies with intake air amount and RPM)
ES–151
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
HINT:
Refer to DTC P0351 (see page ES-171) for the wiring diagram of the ignition system.
Engine Room Relay Block
ECM
No. 1 Injector
#10
AM2
ES
No. 2 Injector
IG2
#20
No. 3 Injector
#30
P/I
No. 4 Injector
MAIN
IG2D
#40
AM2
E01
Power Source Control ECU
E02
A127906E01
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Record DTCs and the freeze frame data.
(c) Switch the ECM from normal mode to check mode using the intelligent tester (see page ES-32).
(d) Read the value on the misfire counter for each cylinder when idling. If the value is displayed on the
misfire counter, skip the following procedure of confirmation driving.
(e) Drive the vehicle several times with an engine speed (ENGINE SPD), engine load (CALC LOAD) and
other data stored in the freeze frame data.
If you have no intelligent tester, turn the power switch OFF after the symptom is simulated once. Then
repeat the simulation process again.
ES–152
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
NOTICE:
In order to memorize the misfire DTCs, it is necessary to drive with MISFIRE RPM and MISFIRE
LOAD in the DATA LIST for the period of time in the chart below. Take care not to turn the power
switch OFF. Turning the power switch OFF switches the diagnosis system from check mode to
normal mode and all DTCs, freeze frame data and other data are erased.
ES
Engine Speed
Time
Idling (Inspection mode)
3 minutes 30 seconds or more
1,000 rpm
3 minutes or more
2,000 rpm
1 minute 30 seconds or more
3,000 rpm
1 minute or more
(f) Check if there is a misfire, DTC and the freeze frame data. Record DTCs, freeze frame data and misfire
counter data.
(g) Turn the power switch OFF and wait at least for 5 seconds.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• If DTCs besides misfire DTCs are memorized simultaneously, troubleshoot the non-misfire DTCs first.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine condition
when malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the
vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or
rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
• If the misfire does not occur when the vehicle is brought to the workshop, the misfire can be confirmed
by reproducing the condition of the freeze frame data. Also, after finishing repairs, confirm that there is
no misfire (see confirmation driving pattern).
• When either of SHORT FT #1 and LONG FT #1 in the freeze frame data is over the range of +-20%,
there is a possibility that the air-fuel ratio is inclining either to RICH (-20% or less) or LEAN (+20% or
more).
• When COOLANT TEMP in the freeze frame data is less than 80°C (176°F), there is a possibility of
misfire only during engine warm-up.
• If the misfire cannot be reproduced, the reason may be because of the driving the vehicle with lack of
fuel, use of improper fuel, a stain on the ignition plug, etc.
• Be sure to check the value on the misfire counter after repairs.
1
CHECK OTHER DTC OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO MISFIRE DTCS)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC output)
Proceed to
P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303 and/or P0304
A
P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303 and/or P0304, and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303
or P0304 are output, perform troubleshooting for those
DTCs first.
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–153
A
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS, CONNECTOR AND VACUUM HOSE IN ENGINE ROOM
(a) Check the connection conditions of the wire harness and
connectors.
(b) Check the vacuum hose piping for disconnection or
breakage.
OK:
Connected correctly and no damage on wire
harness.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE, THEN CONFIRM
THAT THERE IS NO MISFIRE
OK
3
CHECK CONNECTION OF PCV HOSE
OK:
PCV hose is connected correctly, and has no damage.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE PCV HOSE
OK
4
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (NUMBER OF MISFIRE CYLINDER)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Put the engine in inspection mode (see page ES-1).
Start the engine.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / USER DATA / CYL#1 - CYL#4.
(g) Read the number of misfire cylinders on the intelligent
tester.
Result
High Misfire Rate Cylinder
Proceed to
1 or 2 cylinders
A
More than 3 cylinders
B
B
Go to step 15
A
5
CHECK SPARK PLUG AND SPARK OF MISFIRING CYLINDER
(a) Remove the ignition coil.
(b) Remove the spark plug.
ES
ES–154
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(c) Check the spark plug type.
Recommended spark plug:
DENSO made
0.7 to 0.8 mm
ES
B002101E03
SK16R11
(d) Check the spark plug electrode gap.
Electrode gap:
0.7 to 0.8 mm (0.028 to 0.032 in.)
Maximum electrode gap:
1.16 mm (0.046 in.)
NOTICE:
If adjusting the gap of a new spark plug, bend only
the base of the ground electrode. Do not touch the
tip. Never attempt to adjust the gap on the used plug.
(e) Check the electrode for carbon deposits.
(f) Perform a spark test.
CAUTION:
Absolutely disconnect the each injector connector.
NOTICE:
Do not crank the engine for more than 2 seconds.
(1) Install the spark plug to the ignition coil, and connect
the ignition coil connector.
(2) Disconnect the injector connector.
(3) Ground the spark plug.
(4) Check if spark occurs while the engine is being
cranked.
OK:
Spark jumps across electrode gap.
(g) Reinstall the spark plug.
(h) Reinstall the ignition coil.
OK
Go to step 8
NG
6
CHANGE NORMAL SPARK PLUG AND CHECK SPARK OF MISFIRING CYLINDER
(a) Change to the normal spark plug.
(b) Perform a spark test.
CAUTION:
Absolutely disconnect each injector connector.
NOTICE:
Do not crank the engine for more than 2 seconds.
(1) Install the spark plug to the ignition coil, and connect
the ignition coil connector.
(2) Disconnect the injector connector.
(3) Ground the spark plug.
(4) Check if spark occurs while the engine is being
cranked.
OK:
Spark jumps across electrode gap.
OK
NG
REPLACE SPARK PLUG
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
7
ES–155
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR OF MISFIRING CYLINDER (IGNITION COIL - ECM)
(a) Check the harness and connectors between the ignition
coil and ECM (IGF terminal) connectors.
E4
IGF
ECM Connector
(1) Disconnect the I1, I2, I3 or I4 ignition coil connector.
(2) Disconnect the E4 ECM connector.
(3) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Wire Harness Side
Ignition Coil Connector
I1
I2
I3
I4
IGf
Front View
ES
A065743E75
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
I1-2 (IGf) - E4-23 (IGF)
Below 1 Ω
I2-2 (IGf) - E4-23 (IGF)
Below 1 Ω
I3-2 (IGf) - E4-23 (IGF)
Below 1 Ω
I4-2 (IGf) - E4-23 (IGF)
Below 1 Ω
A054393E49
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
I1-2 (IGf) or E4-23 (IGF) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
I2-2 (IGf) or E4-23 (IGF) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
I3-2 (IGf) or E4-23 (IGF) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
I4-2 (IGf) or E4-23 (IGF) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(4) Reconnect the ignition coil connector.
(5) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(b) Check the harness and connectors between the ignition
coil and ECM (IGT terminal) connectors.
E4
IGT4 IGT3 IGT2 IGT1
ECM Connector
A065743E76
ES–156
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(1) Disconnect the I1, I2, I3 or I4 ignition coil connector.
(2) Disconnect the E4 ECM connector.
(3) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Wire Harness Side
Ignition Coil Connector
I1
I2
I3
I4
IGt
Front View
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
I1-3 (IGt) - E4-8 (IGT1)
Below 1 Ω
I2-3 (IGt) - E4-9 (IGT2)
Below 1 Ω
I3-3 (IGt) - E4-10 (IGT3)
Below 1 Ω
I4-3 (IGt) - E4-11 (IGT4)
Below 1 Ω
A054393E50
Standard resistance (Check for short)
ES
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
I1-3 (IGt) or E4-8 (IGT1) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
I2-3 (IGt) or E4-9 (IGT2) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
I3-3 (IGt) or E4-10 (IGT3) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
I4-3 (IGt) or E4-11 (IGT4) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(4) Reconnect the ignition coil connector.
(5) Reconnect the ECM connector.
OK
REPLACE IGNITION COIL (THEN CONFIRM
THAT THERE IS NO MISFIRE)
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
8
CHECK ECM TERMINAL OF MISFIRING CYLINDER (#10. #20. #30 OR #40 VOLTAGE)
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Measure the voltage between the applicable terminals of
the E4 ECM connector.
Standard voltage
E4
E01 #40 #30 #20 #10
ECM Connector
A124045E06
Tester Connection
Specified condition
E4-2 (#10) - E4-7 (E01)
9 to 14 V
E4-3 (#20) - E4-7 (E01)
9 to 14 V
E4-4 (#30) - E4-7 (E01)
9 to 14 V
E4-5 (#40) - E4-7 (E01)
9 to 14 V
OK
Go to step 11
NG
9
INSPECT FUEL INJECTOR RESISTANCE OF MISFIRING CYLINDER
NG
REPLACE FUEL INJECTOR ASSEMBLY
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–157
OK
10
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR OF MISFIRING CYLINDER (INJECTOR - ECM,
INJECTOR - IG2 RELAY)
(a) Check the harness and connectors between the injector
connector and ECM connector.
Wire Harness Side
I5
I6
I7
I8
Front View
ES
Injector Connector
A061031E10
(1) Disconnect the I5, I6, I7 or I8 injector connector.
(2) Disconnect the E4 ECM connector.
(3) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E4
#40 #30
#20 #10
ECM Connector
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
I5-2 (Injector) - E4-2 (#10)
Below 1 Ω
I6-2 (Injector) - E4-3 (#20)
Below 1 Ω
I7-2 (Injector) - E4-4 (#30)
Below 1 Ω
I8-2 (Injector) - E4-5 (#40)
Below 1 Ω
A065743E77
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
I5-2 (Injector) or E4-2 (#10) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
I6-2 (Injector) or E4-3 (#20) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
I7-2 (Injector) or E4-4 (#30) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
I8-2 (Injector) or E4-5 (#40) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(4) Reconnect the injector connector.
(5) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(b) Check the harness and connectors between the injector
connector and IG2 relay.
(1) Disconnect the I5, I6, I7 or I8 injector connector.
(2) Remove the integration relay from the engine room
relay block.
(3) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
4 3I
Engine Room Relay Block
A082810E02
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
I5-1 (Injector) - 3I-4 (IG2 relay)
Below 1 Ω
I6-1 (Injector) - 3I-4 (IG2 relay)
Below 1 Ω
I7-1 (Injector) - 3I-4 (IG2 relay)
Below 1 Ω
I8-1 (Injector) - 3I-4 (IG2 relay)
Below 1 Ω
ES–158
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
I5-1 (Injector) or 3I-4 (IG2 relay) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
I6-1 (Injector) or 3I-4 (IG2 relay) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
I7-1 (Injector) or 3I-4 (IG2 relay) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
I8-1 (Injector) or 3I-4 (IG2 relay) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(4) Reconnect the injector connector.
(5) Reinstall the integration relay connector.
ES
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
11
INSPECT FUEL INJECTOR INJECTION AND VOLUME OF MISFIRING CYLINDER
OK:
Injection volume: 36 to 46 cm3 (2.1 to 2.8 cu in.) per 15
seconds.
NG
REPLACE FUEL INJECTOR ASSEMBLY
OK
12
CHECK CYLINDER COMPRESSION PRESSURE OF MISFIRING CYLINDER
OK:
Compression pressure: 728 kPa (7.4 kgf/cm2, 106 psi)
Minimum pressure: 537 kPa (5.4 kgf/cm2, 77 psi)
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE
OK
13
CHECK VALVE CLEARANCE OF MISFIRING CYLINDER
OK:
Valve clearance (cold):
Intake: 0.17 to 0.23 mm (0.007 to 0.009 in.)
Exhaust: 0.27 to 0.33 mm (0.011 to 0.013 in.)
NG
ADJUST VALVE CLEARANCE
OK
14
SWITCH STEP BY NUMBER OF MISFIRE CYLINDER
HINT:
• If the "1 or 2 cylinders", proceed to A.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–159
• If the "more than 3 cylinders", proceed to B.
B
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
A
15
CHECK VALVE TIMING (CHECK FOR LOOSENESS OR A JUMPED TOOTH OF THE
TIMING CHAIN)
OK:
The match marks of crankshaft pulley and camshaft
pulley are aligning.
NG
ADJUST VALVE TIMING (REPAIR OR
REPLACE TIMING CHAIN)
OK
16
CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
OK:
Fuel pressure: 304 to 343 kPa (3.1 to 3.5 kgf/cm2, 44 to
50 psi)
NG
CHECK AND REPLACE FUEL PUMP,
PRESSURE REGULATOR, FUEL PIPE LINE
AND FILTER
OK
17
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE AND MASS AIR
FLOW RATE)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Check the intake air temperature.
(1) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY /
INTAKE AIR.
(2) Read the value.
Temperature:
Equivalent to ambient air temperature.
(e) Check the air flow rate.
(1) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY / MAF.
(2) Read the value.
OK
Condition
Air flow rate (g/sec.)
Power switch ON (do not start engine)
0.0
Idling (Inspection mode)
3.2 to 4.7
Running without load (Inspection mode, engine speed of 2,500
rpm)
13.1 to 18.9
During vehicle running (Vehicle speed of more than 38 mph)
Air flow rate fluctuates
ES
ES–160
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
NG
REPLACE MASS AIR FLOW METER
OK
18
INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR (RESISTANCE)
(a) Remove the engine coolant temperature sensor.
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the
engine coolant temperature sensor.
Standard resistance
Ohmmeter
Resistance
kΩ
ES
Acceptable
Temperature °C (°F)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1-2
2 to 3 kΩ at 20°C (68°F)
1-2
0.2 to 0.4 kΩ at 80°C (176°F)
NOTICE:
When checking the engine coolant temperature sensor in
water, be careful not to allow water to contact the
terminals. After checking, dry the sensor.
HINT:
Alternate procedure: Connect an ohmmeter to the installed
engine coolant temperature sensor and read the resistance.
Use an infrared thermometer to measure the engine
temperature in the immediate vicinity of the sensor. Compare
these values to the resistance/temperature graph. Change
the engine temperature (warm up or allow to cool down) and
repeat the test.
A081700E08
NG
REPLACE ENGINE COOLANT
TEMPERATURE SENSOR
OK
19
SWITCH STEP BY NUMBER OF MISFIRE CYLINDER
HINT:
• If the "1 or 2 cylinders", proceed to A.
• If the "more than 3 cylinders", proceed to B.
B
A
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
Go to step 5
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–161
DTC
P0325
Knock Sensor 1 Circuit
DTC
P0327
Knock Sensor 1 Circuit Low Input (Bank 1 or
Single Sensor)
DTC
P0328
Knock Sensor 1 Circuit High Input (Bank 1 or
Single Sensor)
DESCRIPTION
A flat type knock sensor (non-resonant type) has the structure that can detect vibration in a wider band of
the frequency from about 6 kHz to 15 kHz and has the following features.
Knock sensors are fitted on the cylinder block to detect engine knocking.
The knock sensor contains a piezoelectric element which generates voltage when it becomes deformed.
The generation of the voltage occurs when the cylinder block vibrates due to the knocking. If the engine
knocking occurs, in order to suppress it, the ignition timing is retarded.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0325
Knock sensor signal level remains at low for 1
second
•
•
•
Open or short in knock sensor circuit
Knock sensor (under-torqued or
looseness)
ECM
P0327
Output voltage of the knock sensor is less
than 0.5 V
•
•
•
Short in knock sensor circuit
Knock sensor
ECM
P0328
Output voltage of the knock sensor is more
than 4.5 V
•
•
•
Open in knock sensor circuit
Knock sensor
ECM
HINT:
If the ECM detects the DTC P0325,P0327 and P0328, it enters fail-safe mode in which the corrective
retarded angle value is set to its maximum value.
Reference: Inspection by using an oscilloscope.
KNK1 Signal Waveform
1V/ DIV.
GND
1 msec./ DIV.
A085286E02
(1) After warming up, run the engine at 2,500 rpm, check the waveform between terminals KNK1 and
EKNK of the ECM connector.
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The knock sensor, located on the cylinder block, detects spark knocks. When the spark knocks occur, the
sensor picks-up vibrates in a specific frequency range. When the ECM detects the voltage in this
frequency range, it retards the ignition timing to suppress the spark knock.
The ECM also senses background engine noise with the knock sensor and uses this noise to check for
faults in the sensor. If the knock sensor signal level is too low for more than 10 seconds, and if the knock
sensor output voltage is out of the normal range, the ECM interprets this as a fault in the knock sensor
and sets a DTC.
ES
ES–162
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
MONITOR STRATEGY
ES
Related DTCs
P0325: Knock sensor (bank 1) range check or rationality
P0327: Knock sensor (bank 1) range check (low voltage)
P0328: Knock sensor (bank 1) range check (high voltage)
Required sensors/components (main)
Main:
Knock sensor
Related: Crankshaft position sensor,
Camshaft position sensor, Engine coolant temperature sensor, Mass
air flow meter
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
1 second
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
None
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
Time after engine start
5 seconds or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Case 1: P0325
Knock sensor voltage
Less than 0.5 V and more than 4.5 V
Case 2: P0327
Knock sensor voltage
Less than 0.5 V
Case 3: P0328
Knock sensor voltage
More than 4.5 V
ES–163
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
Shielded
5V
KNK1
Knock Sensor
ES
EKNK
E1
A120241E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine condition when
malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was
running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or rich, and other data
from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
READ OUTPUT DTCS
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Clear the DTCs.
(f) Put the engine in inspection mode (see page ES-1).
(g) Warm up the engine.
(h) Run the engine at 2,500 rpm for 10 seconds or more.
(i) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC output)
Proceed to
P0325
A
P0325, P0327 and/or P0328
B
ES–164
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Display (DTC output)
Proceed to
No output
C
B
Go to step 3
C
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
A
2
INSPECT KNOCK SENSOR
(a) Check the knock sensor installation.
OK:
Torque: 20 N*m(204 kgf*cm, 15 ft.*lbf)
ES
NG
SECURELY REINSTALL SENSOR
OK
REPLACE KNOCK SENSOR
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (ECM - KNOCK SENSOR)
(a) Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the E5
ECM connector.
Standard resistance
E5
ECM Connector
EKNK
KNK1
A065745E45
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E5-1 (KNK1) - E5-2 (EKNK)
120 to 280 kΩ at 20°C (68°F)
(c) Reconnect the ECM connector.
NG
Go to step 5
OK
4
INSPECT ECM (KNK1 - EKNK VOLTAGE)
(a) Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the E5
ECM terminals.
Standard voltage
EKNK (-)
KNK1 (+)
ECM Connector
A084937E03
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E5-1 (KNK1) - E5-2 (EKNK)
4.5 to 5.5 V
(d)
NG
Reconnect the ECM connector
REPLACE ECM
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–165
OK
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
5
INSPECT KNOCK SENSOR
(a) Remove the knock sensor.
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals.
Standard resistance
Ohmmeter
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
K1-2 (KNK1) - K1-1 (EKNK)
120 to 280 kΩ at 20°C (68°F)
(c)
NG
Reinstall the knock sensor.
REPLACE KNOCK SENSOR
A065174E11
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
ES
ES–166
DTC
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
P0335
Crankshaft Position Sensor "A" Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The crankshaft position sensor (CKP) system consists of a crankshaft position sensor plate and a pick-up
coil. The sensor plate has 34 teeth and is installed on the crankshaft. The pick-up coil is made of an iron
core and magnet. The sensor plate rotates and as each tooth passes through the pick-up coil, a pulse
signal is created. The pick-up coil generates 34 signals per engine revolution. Based on these signals, the
ECM calculates the crankshaft position and engine RPM. Using these calculations, the fuel injection time
and ignition timing are controlled.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0335
No crankshaft position sensor signal to ECM
(2 trip detection logic)
•
ES
•
•
•
Open or short in crankshaft position
sensor circuit
Crankshaft position sensor
Signal plate (crankshaft)
ECM
Reference: Inspection using an oscilloscope.
CH1
(G2)
GND
CH2
(NE)
GND
A083873E02
HINT:
The correct waveform is as shown.
Item
Contents
Terminal
CH1: G2 - NECH2: NE+ - NE-
Equipment Setting
5 V/DIV., 20 ms/DIV.
Condition
During cranking or idling
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
If there is no signal from the crankshaft sensor despite the engine revolving, the ECM interprets this as
malfunction of the sensor.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0335: Crankshaft position sensor range check or rationality
Required sensors/components
Crankshaft position sensor
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
4.7 seconds
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
None
Power switch
ON
ES–167
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Engine rotating signal from HV ECU
HV ECU judges that the engine is running
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Engine speed signal
No signal for 4.7 seconds
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
Camshaft Position Sensor
Shielded
G2
ES
NECrankshaft Position Sensor
Shielded
NE+
E1
A127907E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform troubleshooting on DTC P0335 first. If no trouble is found, troubleshoot the engine mechanical
systems.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine condition
when malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the
vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or
rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
• READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER
(a)Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b)Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(d)Put the engine in inspection mode (see page ES-1).
(e)Start the engine.
(f) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY / ENGINE
SPD.
(g)Read the value.
ES–168
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
• The engine speed can be observed in DATA LIST using the intelligent tester. If there is no NE signal
from the crankshaft position sensor despite the engine revolving, the engine speed will be indicated as
zero. If voltage output from the crankshaft position sensor is insufficient, the engine speed will be
indicated as lower PRM (than the actual RPM).
1
INSPECT CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (RESISTANCE)
(a) Disconnect the C7 crankshaft position sensor connector.
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the
crankshaft position sensor connector.
Standard resistance
Component Side
C7
ES
Front View
Crankshaft Position Sensor
A078431E12
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1-2
985 to 1,600 Ω at cold
1-2
1,265 to 1,890 Ω at hot
NOTICE:
Terms "cold" and "hot" refer to the temperature of
the sensor. "Cold" means approximately -10 to 50°C
(14 to 122°F). "Hot" means approximately 50 to
100°C (122 to 212°F).
(c) Reconnect the crankshaft position sensor connector.
NG
REPLACE CRANKSHAFT POSITION
SENSOR
OK
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR - ECM)
Wire Harness Side
(a) Disconnect the C7 crankshaft position sensor connector.
Front View
C7
NE+
NE-
Crankshaft Position Sensor Connector
A075251E04
(b) Disconnect the E4 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E4
NE+
NE-
ECM Connector
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
C7-1 (NE+) - E4-33 (NE+)
Below 1 Ω
C7-2 (NE-) - E4-34 (NE-)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
A065743E78
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
C7-1 (NE+) or E4-33 (NE+) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
C7-2 (NE-) or E4-34 (NE-) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–169
(d) Reconnect the crankshaft position sensor connector.
(e) Reconnect the ECM connector.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
3
CHECK SENSOR INSTALLATION (CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR)
(a) Check that the crankshaft position sensor is properly
installed.
OK:
Sensor is installed correctly.
NG
SECURELY REINSTALL SENSOR
OK
4
CHECK CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR PLATE (TEETH OF SENSOR PLATE
[CRANKSHAFT])
(a) Check the teeth of the sensor plate.
OK:
No deformation on the teeth of sensor plate.
NG
OK
REPLACE ECM
REPLACE CRANKSHAFT POSITION
SENSOR PLATE
ES
ES–170
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0340
Camshaft Position Sensor Circuit Malfunction
DTC
P0341
Camshaft Position Sensor "A" Circuit Range /
Performance (Bank 1 or Single Sensor)
DESCRIPTION
ES
The variable valve timing (VVT) sensor consists of a magnet, iron core and pickup coil.
The variable valve (VV) signal plate has 3 teeth on its outer circumference and is installed on the
camshaft. When the camshafts rotate, the protrusion on the signal plate and the air gap on the pickup coil
change, causing fluctuations in the magnetic field and generating voltage in the pickup coil.
This sensor monitors a timing rotor located on the camshaft and is used to detect an camshaft angle by
the ECM. The camshaft rotation synchronizes with the crankshaft rotation, and this sensor communicates
the rotation of the camshaft timing rotor as a pulse signal to the ECM. Based on the signal, the ECM
controls fuel injection time and ignition timing.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0340
No camshaft position sensor signal to ECM at
engine speed of 600 rpm or more
(1 trip detection logic)
•
While crankshaft rotates twice, camshaft
position sensor signal is input to ECM 12
times or more (1 trip detection logic)
HINT:
Under normal condition, the camshaft position
sensor signal is input into the ECM 3 times
per 2 engine revolutions
•
P0341
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Open or short in camshaft position sensor
circuit
Camshaft position sensor
Camshaft timing pulley
Timing chain has jumped a tooth
ECM
Open or short in camshaft position sensor
circuit
Camshaft position sensor
Camshaft timing pulley
Timing chain has jumped a tooth
ECM
Reference: Inspection using an oscilloscope.
CH1
(G2)
CH2
(NE)
GND
GND
A083873E02
HINT:
The correct waveform is as shown.
Item
Contents
Terminal
CH1: G2 - NECH2: NE+ - NE-
Equipment Setting
5 V/DIV., 20 ms/DIV.
Condition
During cranking or idling
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
If there is no signal from the VVT sensor even though the engine is turning, or if the rotation of the
camshaft and the crankshaft is not synchronized, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction of the sensor.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–171
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0340: Camshaft position sensor (bank 1) range check or rationality
P0341: Camshaft position sensor (bank 1) range check or rationality
Required sensors/components
Main:
Camshaft position sensor
Related:
Crankshaft position sensor, engine speed sensor
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
5 seconds
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
ES
P0340:
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
None
Engine speed
600 rpm or more
P0341:
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
None
Engine rotating signal from HV ECU
HV ECU judges that engine is running
Engine revolution angle
720 °CA*
*: CA stands for Crankshaft Angle.
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P0340:
Crankshaft/camshaft synchronization
Not synchronized (judged by comparing the crankshaft position with
the camshaft position)
Camshaft position sensor signal
No input in appropriate timing
P0341:
Crankshaft/Camshaft synchronization
Not synchronized
Camshaft position sensor count
12 or more / 720°CA* (= 2 engine revolutions)
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Camshaft position sensor signal input every 720°CA
3 times
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0335 (see page ES-160).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine condition when
malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was
running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or rich, and other data
from the time the malfunction occurred.
ES–172
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
1
INSPECT CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (RESISTANCE)
(a) Disconnect the C1 camshaft position sensor connector.
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals of
camshaft position sensor connector.
Standard resistance
Component Side
Camshaft Position Sensor
C1
Front View
ES
A073303E08
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1-2
1,630 to 2,740 Ω at cold
1-2
2,065 to 3,225 Ω at hot
NOTICE:
Terms "cold" and "hot" refer to the temperature of
the sensor. "Cold" means approximately -10 to 50°°C
(14 to 122°F). "Hot" means approximately 50 to
100°C (122 to 212°F).
(c) Reconnect the camshaft position sensor connector.
NG
REPLACE CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
OK
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the C1 camshaft position sensor connector.
Wire Harness Side
C1
Front View
NEG2
Camshaft Position Sensor
A066132E06
(b) Disconnect the E4 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E4
G2
NE-
ECM Connector
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
C1-1 (G2) - E4-26 (G2)
Below 1 Ω
C1-2 (NE-) - E4-34 (NE-)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
A065743E79
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
C1-1 (G2) or E4-26 (G2) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
C1-2 (NE-) or E4-34 (NE-) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the camshaft position sensor connector.
(e) Reconnect the ECM connector.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
NG
ES–173
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
3
CHECK SENSOR INSTALLATION (CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR)
(a) Check that the camshaft position sensor is properly
installed.
OK:
Sensor is installed correctly.
NG
SECURELY REINSTALL SENSOR
OK
4
CHECK CAMSHAFT TIMING GEAR ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the camshaft.
(b) Check the camshaft lobes.
OK:
No deformation on the camshaft lobe.
NG
OK
REPLACE ECM
REPLACE CAMSHAFT TIMING GEAR
ASSEMBLY
ES
ES–174
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0351
Ignition Coil "A" Primary / Secondary Circuit
DTC
P0352
Ignition Coil "B" Primary / Secondary Circuit
DTC
P0353
Ignition Coil "C" Primary / Secondary Circuit
DTC
P0354
Ignition Coil "D" Primary / Secondary Circuit
DESCRIPTION
ES
HINT:
• These DTCs indicate malfunction related to the primary circuit.
• If DTC P0351 is displayed, check the No.1 (#1) ignition coil circuit.
• If DTC P0352 is displayed, check the No.2 (#2) ignition coil circuit.
• If DTC P0353 is displayed, check the No.3 (#3) ignition coil circuit.
• If DTC P0354 is displayed, check the No.4 (#4) ignition coil circuit.
A Direct Ignition System (DIS) is used on this vehicle.
The DIS is a 1-cylinder ignition system which ignites one cylinder with one ignition coil. In the 1-cylinder
ignition system, the one spark plug is connected to the end of the secondary winding. High voltage
generated in the secondary winding is applied directly to the spark plug. The spark of the spark plug
passes from the center electrode to the ground electrode.
The ECM determines the ignition timing and outputs the ignition (IGT) signals for each cylinder. Using the
IGT signal, the ECM turns ON and OFF the power transistor inside the igniter and this switches ON and
OFF the current to the primary coil. When the current flow to the primary coil is cut off, high-voltage is
generated in the secondary coil and this voltage is applied to the spark plugs to spark inside the cylinders.
As the ECM cuts the current to the primary coil, the igniter sends back the ignition confirmation (IGF)
signal to the ECM.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ECM
Igniter
ES–175
From Battery
No. 1 (#1) Ignition Coil
IGT1
Crankshaft Position Sensor
No. 1 Spark Plug
IGF
No. 2 Spark Plug
IGT2
No. 2 (#2) Ignition Coil
Camshaft Position Sensor
Other Sensors
(Engine Coolant Temperature Sensor, Mass Air Flow
Meter, Throttle Position
Sensor, etc.)
ES
No. 3 Spark Plug
IGT3
No. 3 (#3) Ignition Coil
No. 4 Spark Plug
IGT4
No. 4 (#4) Ignition Coil
NEO
HV ECU
A125449E01
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0351
P0352
P0353
P0354
No IGF signal to ECM while engine is running
•
•
•
•
Reference: Inspection using an oscilloscope.
CH1
(IGT1
to 4)
CH2
(IGF)
GND
GND
A063956E08
Ignition system
Open or short in IGF or IGT circuit from
ignition coil with igniter to ECM (ignition
coil circuit 1 through 4)
Ignition coil with igniter (ignition coil circuit
1 through 4)
ECM
ES–176
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
HINT:
The correct waveform is as shown.
Item
Contents
Terminal
CH1: IGT1, IGT2, IGT3, IGT4 - E1
CH2: IGF - E1
Equipment Setting
2 V/DIV., 20 ms/DIV.
Condition
While the engine is cranking or idling
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
Ignition Coil with Igniter
ES
IGT
ECM
Ignition Coil
Igniter
IGF
Ignition Signal (IGT)
Normal
Ignition
Confirmation
Signal (IGF)
Open
Open
Time
A082388E04
If the ECM does not receive the ignition confirmation (IGF) signal after sending the ignition (IGT) signal,
the ECM interprets this as a fault in the igniter and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0351: Ignition coil with igniter circuit (#1) malfunction
P0352: Ignition coil with igniter circuit (#2) malfunction
P0353: Ignition coil with igniter circuit (#3) malfunction
P0354: Ignition coil with igniter circuit (#4) malfunction
Required sensors/components
Igniter
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
0.256 seconds
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–177
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
None
Engine speed
1,500 rpm or less
Either of the following conditions is met:
(a) or (b)
(a) Following conditions are met:
1&2
1. Engine speed
500 rpm or less
2. Battery voltage
6 V or more
(b) Following conditions are met:
1&2
1. Engine speed
More than 500 rpm
2. Battery voltage
10 V or more
ES
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Ignition signal fail count*
More than 2 times
*: Counted when the IGF signal is not returned to the ECM despite sending the IGT signal.
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Number of IGF signals
Equals the number of IGT signals
ES–178
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
Engine Room Relay Block
AM2
No. 1 Ignition
Coil
IGT1
IGF
IG2
ES
IG2D
P/I
MAIN
No. 2 Ignition
Coil
IGT2
No. 3 Ignition
Coil
IGT3
No. 4 Ignition
Coil
IGT4
AM2
Power Source
Control ECU
E1
Noise Filter
A127918E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine condition when
malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was
running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or rich, and other data
from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
CHECK SPARK PLUG AND SPARK OF MISFIRING CYLINDER
OK:
Spark occurs.
NG
Go to step 4
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–179
OK
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (IGNITION COIL - ECM (IGF SIGNAL TERMINAL))
(a) Disconnect the I1, I2, I3 or I4 ignition coil and igniter
connector.
Wire Harness Side
Ignition Coil Connector
I1
I2
I3
I4
IGf
Front View
ES
A054393E52
(b) Disconnect the E4 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E4
IGF
ECM Connector
A065743E80
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
I1-2 (IGf) - E4-23 (IGF)
Below 1 Ω
I2-2 (IGf) - E4-23 (IGF)
Below 1 Ω
I3-2 (IGf) - E4-23 (IGF)
Below 1 Ω
I4-2 (IGf) - E4-23 (IGF)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
I1-2 (IGf) or E4-23 (IGF) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
I2-2 (IGf) or E4-23 (IGF) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
I3-2 (IGf) or E4-23 (IGF) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
I4-2 (IGf) or E4-23 (IGF) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the ignition coil and igniter connector.
(e) Reconnect the ECM connector.
NG
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
ES–180
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
3
CHECK ECM (IGF VOLTAGE)
(a) Disconnect the I1, I2, I3 or I4 ignition coil and igniter
connector.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Measure the voltage between the specified terminals of
the E4 and E5 ECM connectors.
Standard voltage
E5
E4
IGF (+)
E1 (-)
ECM Connector
ES
A124045E07
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E4-23 (IGF) - E5-28 (E1)
4.5 to 5.5 V
(d) Reconnect the ignition coil and igniter connector.
NG
REPLACE ECM
OK
REPLACE IGNITION COIL
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (IGNITION - ECM (IGT SIGNAL TERMINAL))
(a) Disconnect the I1, I2, I3 or I4 ignition coil and igniter
connector.
E4
IGT4 IGT3 IGT2 IGT1
ECM Connector
A065743E76
(b) Disconnect the E4 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Wire Harness Side
Ignition Coil Connector
I1
I2
I3
I4
IGt
Front View
A054393E50
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
I1-3 (IGt) - E4-8 (IGT1)
Below 1 Ω
I2-3 (IGt) - E4-9 (IGT2)
Below 1 Ω
I3-3 (IGt) - E4-10 (IGT3)
Below 1 Ω
I4-3 (IGt) - E4-11 (IGT4)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
I1-3 (IGT) or E4-8 (IGT1) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
I2-3 (IGT) or E4-9 (IGT2) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
I3-3 (IGT) or E4-10 (IGT3) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
I4-3 (IGT) or E4-11 (IGT4) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–181
(d) Reconnect the ignition coil and igniter connector.
(e) Reconnect the ECM connector.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
5
CHECK ECM (IGT1, IGT2, IGT3 OR IGT4 VOLTAGE)
E4
E5
(a) Measure the voltage between the applicable terminals of
the E4 and E5 ECM connectors when the engine is
cranked.
Standard voltage
E1 (-)
IGT4 (+) IGT3 (+) IGT2 (+) IGT1 (+)
ECM Connector
A124045E08
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E4-8 (IGT1) - E5-28 (E1)
0.1 to 4.5 V
E4-9 (IGT2) - E5-28 (E1)
0.1 to 4.5 V
E4-10 (IGT3) - E5-28 (E1)
0.1 to 4.5 V
E4-11 (IGT4) - E5-28 ( E1)
0.1 to 4.5 V
NG
REPLACE ECM
OK
6
CHECK ECM (IGT1, IGT2, IGT3 OR IGT4 VOLTAGE)
E4
E5
(a) Disconnect the I1, I2, I3 or I4 ignition coil and igniter
connector.
(b) Measure the voltage between the applicable terminals of
the E4 and E5 ECM connectors when the engine is
cranked.
Standard voltage
E1 (-)
IGT4 (+) IGT3 (+) IGT2 (+) IGT1 (+)
ECM Connector
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E4-8 (IGT1) - E5-28 (E1)
4.5 V or more
E4-9 (IGT2) - E5-28 (E1)
4.5 V or more
E4-10 (IGT3) - E5-28 (E1)
4.5 V or more
E4-11 (IGT4) - E5-28 (E1)
4.5 V or more
A124045E08
(c) Reconnect the ignition coil and igniter connector.
NG
OK
REPLACE ECM
ES
ES–182
7
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK IGNITION COIL (POWER SOURCE)
Wire Harness Side
I1
I2
I3
I4
Front View
+B (+)
GND (-)
Ignition Coil and Igniter Connector
ES
(a) Disconnect the I1, I2, I3 or I4 ignition coil and igniter
connector.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Measure the voltage between the terminal of the wire
harness side connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
I1-1 (+B) - I1-4 (GND)
9 to 14 V
I2-1 (+B) - I2-4 (GND)
9 to 14 V
I3-1 (+B) - I3-4 (GND)
9 to 14 V
I4-1 (+B) - I4-4 (GND)
9 to 14 V
A054393E53
(d) Reconnect the ignition coil and igniter connector.
OK
REPLACE IGNITION COIL
NG
8
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (IGNITION COIL - IG2 RELAY)
(a) Disconnect the I1, I2, I3 or I4 ignition coil and igniter
connector.
Wire Harness Side
I1
I2
I3
I4
Front View
+B (+)
GND (-)
Ignition Coil and Igniter Connector
A054393E53
(b) Remove the integration relay from engine room relay
block.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
4 3I
Engine Room Relay Block
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
I1-1 (+B) - 3I-4 (IG2 relay)
Below 1 Ω
I2-1 (+B) - 3I-4 (IG2 relay)
Below 1 Ω
I3-1 (+B) - 3I-4 (IG2 relay)
Below 1 Ω
I4-1 (+B) - 3I-4 (IG2 relay)
Below 1 Ω
I1-4 (GND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
I2-4 (GND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
I3-4 (GND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
I4-4 (GND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
A082810E02
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
I1-1 (+B) or 3I-4 (IG2 relay) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
I2-1 (+B) or 3I-4 (IG2 relay) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
I3-1 (+B) or 3I-4 (IG2 relay) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
I4-1 (+B) - 3I-4 (IG2 relay)
10 kΩ or higher
ES–183
(d) Reconnect the ignition coil and igniter connector.
(e) Reinstall the integration relay.
NG
OK
REPLACE IGNITION COIL
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
ES
ES–184
DTC
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
P0420
Catalyst System Efficiency Below Threshold
(Bank 1)
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
ES
The ECM uses 2 sensors mounted before and after the three-way catalytic converter (TWC) to monitor its'
efficiency. The air-fuel ratio (A/F) sensor (sensor 1) sends pre-catalyst information to the ECM. The
heated oxygen (O2) sensor (sensor 2) sends post-catalyst information to the ECM.
In order to detect deterioration in the catalyst, the ECM calculates Oxygen Storage Capacity (OSC) in the
catalyst based on voltage output of the sensor 2 while performing "active air-fuel ratio control" instead of
the conventional detecting method which uses the locus ratio.
The OSC is an indication value of the catalyst oxygen storage capacity and is used for representing how
much the catalyst can store oxygen. When the vehicle is being driven with a warm engine, the active airfuel ratio control is performed for approximately 15 to 20 seconds. When it is performed, the air-fuel ratio
is forcibly regulated to go LEAN or RICH by the ECM, and if a RICH and LEAN cycle of the sensor 2 is
long, the OSC will become greater. The greater OSC and capability of the catalyst are mutually related.
The ECM judges if the catalyst has deteriorated based on the calculated OSC value. The ECM will
illuminate the MIL and a DTC will be set.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0420
OSC value is smaller than the standard value
under "active air-fuel ratio control"
•
•
•
•
Exhaust manifold with front catalyst and
exhaust front pipe with rear catalyst
Gas leakage in exhaust system
A/F sensor
Heated oxygen sensor
HINT:
• Sensor 1 refers to the sensor mounted before the TWC and is located near the engine assembly.
• Sensor 2 refers to the sensor mounted after the TWC and is located far from the engine assembly.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0420: Bank 1 catalyst is deterioration
Required sensors/components
Main:
A/F sensor, heated oxygen sensor
Related:
Mass air flow meter, engine coolant temperature sensor, engine speed
sensor, intake air temperature sensor
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
30 seconds
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of operation
None
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–185
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
P0011 (VVT system 1 - Advance)
P0012 (VVT system 1 - Retard)
P0031, P0032 (A/F sensor heater - Sensor 1)
P0037, P0038 (O2 sensor heater - Sensor 2)
P0100 - P0103 (MAF meter)
P0115 - P0118 (ECT sensor)
P0120 - P0223, P2135 (TP sensor)
P0125 (Insufficient ECT for closed loop)
P0136 (O2 sensor - Sensor 2)
P0171, P0172 (Fuel system)
P0300 - P0304 (Misfire)
P0335 (CKP sensor)
P0340, P0341 (CMP sensor)
P0351-P0354 (Igniter)
P0442 - P0456 (EVAP system)
P0500 (VSS)
P2196 (A/F sensor - Rationality)
P2A00 (A/F sensor - Slow response)
Battery voltage
11.5 V or more
Altitude
Less than 2,400 m (8,000 ft)
Intake air temperature
-10 °C (14°F) or more
Idle
OFF
Engine speed
Less than 3,200 rpm
Engine coolant temperature
75°C (157°F) or more
Estimated catalyst temperature conditions are met:
1&2
1. Upstream estimated catalyst temperature
Less than 800°C (1,508°F), and 430°C (806°F) or more
2. Downstream estimated catalyst temperature
Less than 675°C (1,292°F), and 290°C (554°F) or more
Fuel system status
Closed-loop
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Oxygen storage capacity
Less than 0.03 g
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to detailed information (see page ES-15).
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
PURPOSE (see page ES-17)
HINT:
Performing this confirmation pattern will activate the catalyst monitoring by the ECM. This is very useful
for verifying the completion of repairs.
ES
ES–186
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Vehicle Speed
NOTICE:
This test will not be completed if
the vehicle drives under an
absolutely constant speed by the
cruise control etc.
70 to 113 km/h
(40 to 70 mph)
Idling
Power Switch OFF
ES
Warming up
5 to 10 minutes
Time
Note: Momentary vehicle stop during this drive will not interrupt the test)
A079199E57
(a) Clear the DTCs.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / CARB OBD II / READINESS TESTS. Check that CAT EVAL
is INCMPL (incomplete).
A076855E02
(d) Drive the vehicle according to the confirmation driving pattern. Note the state of the Readiness Tests.
They will change to COMPL (complete) as the CAT evaluation monitors operate.
(e) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DTC INFO / PENDING CODES.
Check if any DTC (any pending code) is set.
If the READINESS CODE of CAT EVAL was INCMPL and any DTC (includes pending codes) was not set,
extend the driving time.
NOTICE:
If you do not have the intelligent tester, perform again the same confirmation driving pattern after
turning OFF the power switch upon finishing the first confirmation driving pattern.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–187
CONDITIONING FOR SENSOR TESTING
Engine Speed
(d)
(c)
2,500 rpm
1,500 rpm
(b)
Idling
Power Switch OFF
(a)
Warming up
Time
Approximately 3 minutes
2 seconds
Check
A092787E01
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Put the engine in inspection mode (see page ES-1).
(c) Start the engine and warm it up with all the accessories switched OFF until the engine coolant
temperature becomes table.
(d) Run the engine at 2,500 rpm for approximately 3 minutes.
(e) Run the engine at 2,500 rpm for 2 seconds and then 1,500 rpm for 2 seconds.
(f) Check the waveform of the oxygen sensor (sensor 2).
HINT:
If output of the A/F sensor or the heated oxygen sensor does not fluctuate or has noise, the sensor may
be malfunctioning.
If voltage output of both sensors remain at LEAN or RICH, the air-fuel ratio may be extremely LEAN or
RICH. In such a case, perform the following A/F CONTROL operation in ACTIVE TEST using the
intelligent tester. If the catalyst has deteriorated, the voltage output of the heated oxygen sensor fluctuates
up and down widely even under normal driving ("active air-fuel ratio control" is not performed).
Voltage output when active air-fuel ratio control not performed
Normal Catalyst
Waveform of
A/F Sensor
before Catalyst
Waveform of
Heated Oxygen
Sensor after
Catalyst
Deteriorated Catalyst
3.5 V
3.0 V
1.0 V
0V
10 seconds
10 seconds
A076893E07
ES
ES–188
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
ES
HINT:
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine condition
when malfunction is detection. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the
vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or
rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
• Malfunctioning areas can be found by performing the ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL operation. The
A/F CONTROL operation can determine if the A/F sensor, heated oxygen sensor or other potential
trouble area are malfunctioning or not.
(a) Perform the ACTIVE TEST A/F CONTROL operation..
• The A/F CONTROL operation lowers the injection volume 12.5% or increases the injection volume
25%.
(1) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(3) Put the engine in inspection mode (see page ES-1).
(4) Warm up the engine by running the engine at 2,500 rpm, depressing the accelerator pedal more
than 60% for approximately 90 seconds.
(5) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL.
(6) Perform the A/F CONTROL operation with the engine in an idle condition (press the right or left
button).
Result:
A/F sensor reacts in accordance with increase and decrease of injection volume:
+25% → rich output: Less than 3.0 V
-12.5% → lean output: More than 3.35 V
Heated oxygen sensor reacts in accordance with increase and decrease of injection volume:
+25% → rich output: More than 0.55 V
-12.5% → lean output: Less than 0.4 V
NOTICE:
The A/F sensor output has a few seconds of delay and the heated oxygen sensor output has about
20 seconds of delay at maximum.
Case
A/F Sensor (Sensor 1) Output Voltage
Main Suspected
Trouble Area
HO2 Sensor (Sensor 2) Output Voltage
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
Output Voltage
More than 0.55 V
Less than 0.4 V
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Output Voltage
More than 0.55 V
Less than 0.4 V
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
-
1
2
3
•
•
•
A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
A/F sensor circuit
•
•
•
HO2 sensor
HO2 sensor heater
HO2 sensor circuit
ES–189
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Case
A/F Sensor (Sensor 1) Output Voltage
Main Suspected
Trouble Area
HO2 Sensor (Sensor 2) Output Voltage
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
•
•
•
4
Fuel Injector
Fuel pressure
Gas leakage from
exhaust system (Airfuel ratio extremely
or lean rich)
The following A/F CONTROL procedure enables the technician to check and graph the voltage output of
both A/F sensor and heated oxygen sensor.
To display the graph, enter ACTIVE TEST/ A/F CONTROL/USER DATA, select "AFS B1S1 and O2S
B1S2" by pressing the "YES" button followed by the "ENTER" button and then the "F4" button.
1
CHECK OTHER DTC OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P0420)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P0420
A
P0420 and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides P0420 are output, perform
troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
A
2
CHECK FOR EXHAUST GUS LEAKAGE
OK:
No gas leakage.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE EXHAUST GAS
LEAKAGE POINT
OK
3
INSPECT AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR (BANK 1 SENSOR 1)
NG
OK
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
ES
ES–190
4
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECT HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (BANK 1 SENSOR 2)
NG
REPLACE HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
OK
REPLACE THREE-WAY CATALYTIC CONVERTER (REPLACE FRONT PIPE)
ES
ES–191
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P043E
Evaporative Emission System Reference Orifice Clog Up
DTC
P043F
Evaporative Emission System Reference Orifice High Flow
DTC
P2401
Evaporative Emission Leak Detection Pump
Stuck OFF
DTC
P2402
Evaporative Emission Leak Detection Pump
Stuck ON
DTC
P2419
Evaporative Emission Pressure Switching
Valve Stuck ON
DTC SUMMARY
DTC No.
P043E
P043F
P2401
P2402
P2419
Monitoring Items
Reference orifice
clogged
Malfunction
Detection
Conditions
P043E, P043F,
P2401, P2402 and
P2419 are present
when one of the
following conditions is
met during key-off
EVAP monitor:
• EVAP pressure
just after
reference
pressure
measurement
greater than 752
mmHg-a
• Reference
pressure less
than 724 mmHga
• Reference
pressure greater
than 752 mmHga
• Reference
pressure is not
saturated
• Reference
pressure
difference
between first and
second is 5
mmHg-g or more
HINT:
These values are
typical
Trouble Areas
•
•
•
•
Canister pump
module
(Reference
orifice, leak
detection pump,
vent valve)
Connector/wire
harness
(Canister pump
module - ECM)
EVAP system
hose (pipe from
air inlet port to
canister pump
module, canister
filter, fuel tank
vent hose)
ECM
Detection Timing
Power switch OFF
Detection Logic
2 trip
ES
ES–192
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DESCRIPTION
ES
NOTICE:
In this vehicle's EVAP system, turning ON the vent valve does not seal off the EVAP system. To
check for leaks in the EVAP system, disconnect the air inlet vent hose and apply pressure from
the atmosphere side of the canister.
While the engine is running, if a predetermined condition (closed loop, etc.) is met, the purge VSV is
opened by the ECM and stored fuel vapors in the canister are purged to the intake manifold. The ECM
changes the duty cycle ratio of the purge VSV to control purge flow volume.
The purge flow volume is also determined by the intake manifold pressure. Atmospheric pressure is
allowed into the canister through the vent valve to ensure that the purge flow is maintained when the
negative pressure (vacuum) is applied to the canister.
Key-off monitor
This monitor checks for Evaporative Emission (EVAP) system leaks and canister pump module
malfunctions. The monitor starts 5 hours* after the power switch is turned OFF. More than 5 hours are
required to allow the fuel to cool down to stabilize the Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP), thus making the EVAP
system monitor more accurate.
The leak detection pump creates negative pressure (vacuum) in the EVAP system and the pressure is
measured. Finally, the ECM monitors for leaks from the EVAP system and malfunctions in both the
canister pump module and purge VSV, based on the EVAP pressure.
HINT:
*: If the engine coolant temperature is not below 35°C (95°F) 5 hours after the power switch is turned OFF,
the monitor check starts 2 hours later. If it is still not below 35°C (95°F) 7 hours after the power switch is
turned OFF, the monitor check starts 2.5 hours later.
ES–193
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Location
EVAP Hose (From Canister)
Purge Line
EVAP Hose (To Intake Manifold)
Purge VSV
ES
Pump Module
Trap Canister
- Leak Detection Pump
- Canister Pressure Sensor
- Vent Valve
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor
Pressure Switching Valve
Canister Filter
Canister
Fuel Tank
Air Inlet Port
Fuel Cap
A131350E01
ES–194
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Diagram
Intake Manifold
Purge VSV
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor
ES
Fuel Cap
Pressure Switching Valve
Fresh Air Line
Canister
Fuel Pump Chamber
Canister Filter
Bladder Tank
Trap Canister with Pump Module
Outer Tank
Roll Over Valve
A130305E01
Pump Module
: Air Flow
Vent Valve (ON)
From
Canister
Filter
Trap Canister
Vent Valve (OFF)
Reference Orifice
Pressure Sensor
Leak Detection Pump (OFF)
Leak Detection Pump (ON)
A131438E01
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–195
Canister Pressure Sensor Specification
Malfunction Area
Output Voltage
4.900 V
4.150 V
Usable Range
ES
1.425 V
Malfunction Area
0.450 V
60 kPa
110 kPa
(450 mmHg) (825 mmHg)
Pressure
HINT:
Standard atmospheric pressure is 101.3 kPa (760mmHg)
A115543E09
Components
Operations
Canister, Trap canister
Contains activated charcoal to absorb EVAP generated in fuel tank.
Cut-off valve
Located in fuel tank. Valve floats and closes when fuel tank 100% full.
Purge Vacuum Switching Valve (VSV)
Opens or closes line between canister and intake manifold. ECM uses
purge VSV to control EVAP purge flow. In order to discharge EVAP
absorbed by canister to intake manifold, ECM opens purge VSV.
EVAP discharge volume to intake manifold controlled by purge VSV
duty cycle ratio (current-carrying time) (open: ON; closed: OFF).
Roll-over valve
Located in fuel tank. Valve closes by its own weight when vehicle
overturns to prevent fuel from spilling out.
Soak timer
Built into ECM. To ensure accurate EVAP monitor, measures 5 hours
(+-15 min) after power switch OFF. This allows fuel to cool down,
stabilizing Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP). When approximately 5 hours
elapsed, ECM activates.
Pressure switching valve
The pressure switching valve located on the canister is used to detect
leakage from the bladder tank into the fuel tank. The valve opens
during the bladder tank leak check. Then, the fuel tank's fuel vapor
flows to the intake manifold without passing the canister.
Pump module
Consists of (a) to (d) below. pump module cannot be disassembled.
(a) Vent valve
Vents and closes EVAP system. When ECM turns valve ON, EVAP
system closed. When ECM turns valve OFF, EVAP system vented.
Negative pressure (vacuum) created in EVAP system to check for
EVAP leaks by closing purge VSV, turning vent valve ON (closed) and
operating leak detection pump.
(b) Canister pressure sensor
Indicates pressure as voltage. ECM supplies regulated 5 V to canister
pressure sensor, and uses feedback from sensor to monitor EVAP
system pressure.
(c) Leak detection pump
Creates negative pressure (vacuum) in EVAP system for leak check.
ES–196
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Components
Operations
Has opening with 0.02 inch diameter. Vacuum produced through
orifice by closing purge VSV, turning vent valve OFF and operating
leak detection pump to monitor 0.02 inch leak criterion. 0.02 inch leak
criterion indicates small leak of EVAP.
(d) Reference orifice
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
ES
5 hours* after the power switch is turned OFF, the leak detection pump creates negative pressure
(vacuum) in the EVAP system. The ECM monitors for leaks and actuator malfunctions based on the EVAP
pressure.
HINT:
*: If the engine coolant temperature is not below 35°C (95°F) 5 hours after the power switch is turned OFF,
the monitor check starts 2 hours later. If it is still not below 35°C (95°F) 7 hours after the power switch is
turned OFF, the monitor check starts 2.5 hours later.
Sequence
Descriptions
Duration
ECM activation
Activated by soak timer 5, 7 or 9.5
hours after power switch OFF.
-
Atmospheric pressure
measurement
Vent valve turned OFF (vent) and
EVAP system pressure measured
by ECM in order to register
atmospheric pressure.
If pressure in EVAP system not
between 70 kPa and 110 kPa
(525 mmHg and 825 mmHg),
ECM cancels EVAP system
monitor.
10 seconds
First 0.02 inch leak criterion
measurement
In order to determine 0.02 inch
leak criterion, leak detection
pump creates negative pressure
(vacuum) through reference
orifice and then ECM checks if
leak detection pump and vent
valve operate normally.
60 seconds
EVAP system pressure
measurement
Vent valve turned ON (closed) to
shut EVAP system.
Negative pressure (vacuum)
created in EVAP system, and
EVAP system pressure then
measured.
Write down measured value as it
will be used in leak check.
If EVAP pressure does not
stabilize within 900 seconds,
ECM cancels EVAP system
monitor.
900 seconds*
Purge VSV monitor
Purge VSV opened and then
EVAP system pressure measured
by ECM.
Large increase indicates normal.
10 seconds
E
Second 0.02 inch leak criterion
measurement
After second 0.02 inch leak
criterion measurement, leak
check performed by comparing
first and second 0.02 inch leak
criterion.
If stabilized system pressure
higher than second 0.02 inch leak
criterion, ECM determines that
EVAP system leaking.
60 seconds
-
Final check
Atmospheric pressure measured
and then monitoring result
recorded by ECM.
-
-
A
B
C
D
Operations
*: If only a small amount of fuel is in the fuel tank, it takes longer for the EVAP pressure to stabilize.
ES–197
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Operation A: Atmospheric Pressure Measurement
Purge VSV: OFF
Canister
Fuel Tank
Vent Valve: OFF (vent)
Reference
Orifice
Canister
Pressure
Sensor
Operation B, E: 0.02 Inch Leak
Criterion Measurement
OFF
OFF (vent)
Canister Pump Module
Canister Filter
ES
ON
Leak Detection Pump: OFF
Operation C: EVAP System Pressure Measurement
OFF
ON
ON (closed)
Atmospheric
Pressure
Negative
Pressure
Operation D: Purge VSV Monitor
ON
ON (closed)
ON
A122912E01
In sequences B and E, the leak detection pump creates negative pressure (vacuum) through the
reference orifice. If the pressure is lower than 724 mmHg-a, higher than 752 mmHg-a, is not saturated
and the pressure difference at sequences B and E is large, the ECM interprets this as a clog malfunction
in the reference orifice, and stops the EVAP system monitor. The ECM then illuminates the MIL and sets
the DTC (2 trip detection logic).
These values vary with atmospheric pressure. Atmospheric pressure = 760 mmHg-a = 101.3 kPa
ES–198
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ON
Purge VSV
ON: Open
OFF: Closed
ON: Closed
ON
Vent Valve
OFF: Vent
Leak Detection
Pump
ON
EVAP Pressure
ES
Positive
Negative
OK
Malfunction
Sequence
A
Time (Second)
10
4 B
60
C
D
E
Within 900
10
60
A135976E01
MONITOR STRATEGY
Required Sensors/Components
Purge VSV and canister pump module
Frequency of Operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
Maximum 15 seconds
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
P0011, P0012, P0021, P0022 (VVT system-Advance, Retard)
P0100, P0101, P0102, P0103 (MAF sensor)
P0110, P0112, P0113 (IAT sensor)
P0115, P0116, P0117, P0118 (ECT sensor)
P0120, P0122, P0123, P0220, P0222, P0223, P2135,(TP sensor)
P0125 (Insufficient ECT for closed loop)
P0171, P0172, P0174, P0175 (Fuel system)
P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303, P0304 (Misfire)
P0335 (CKP sensor)
P0340, P0341 (CMP sensor)
P0351, P0352, P0353, P0354 (Igniter)
P0450, P0452, P0453 (EVAP press sensor)
P0500 (VSS)
Atmospheric pressure
70 to 110 kPa (525 to 825 mmHg)
Battery voltage
10.5 V or higher
Vehicle speed
Less than 4 km/h (2.5 mph)
Power switch
OFF
Time after key off
5 or 7 or 9.5 hours
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Purge VSV
Not operated by scan tool
Vent valve
Not operated by scan tool
Leak detection pump
Not operated by scan tool
Both of the following conditions 1 and 2 are met before key off
-
1. Duration that vehicle has been driven
5 minutes or more
2. EVAP purge operation
Performed
ECT
4.4 to 35°C (40 to 95°F)
IAT
4.4 to 35°C (40 to 95°F)
ES–199
1. Key-off monitor sequence 1 to 8
1. Atmospheric pressure measurement
Next sequence is run if the following condition is met
-
Atmospheric pressure change
Within 0.3 kPa (2.25 mmHg) in 1 second
2. First reference pressure measurement
Next sequence is run if the following conditions are met
-
EVAP pressure just after reference pressure measurement start
-1 kPa (-7.5 mmHg) or lower
Reference pressure
-4.85 to -1.05 kPa (726 to 754 mmHg)
Reference pressure
Saturated within 60 seconds
3. Vent valve stuck closed check
Next sequence is run if the following condition is met
-
EVAP pressure change after vent valve is ON
0.3 kPa (2.25 mmHg) or more
4. Vacuum introduction
Next sequence is run if the following condition is met
-
EVAP pressure
Saturated within 900 seconds
5. Purge VSV stuck closed check
Next sequence is run if the following condition is met
-
EVAP pressure change after purge VSV is open
0.3 kPa (2.25 mmHg) or more
6. Second reference pressure measurement
Next sequence is run if the following conditions are met
-
EVAP pressure just after reference pressure measurement
-1 kPa (-7.5 mmHg) or lower
Reference pressure
-4.85 to -1.05 kPa (726 to 754 mmHg)
Reference pressure
Saturated within 60 seconds
Reference pressure difference between first and second
Less than 0.7 kPa (5.25 mmHg)
7. Leak check
Next sequence is run if the following condition is met
-
EVAP pressure when vacuum introduction is complete
Lower than second reference pressure
8. Atmospheric pressure measurement
EVAP monitor is complete if the following condition is met
-
Atmospheric pressure difference between sequence 1 and 8
Within 0.3 kPa (2.25 mmHg)
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
"Saturated" indicates that the EVAP pressure change is less than 0.1 kPa (0.75 mmHg) in 30 seconds.
One of following conditions met
-
FTP when just after reference pressure measurement began
Higher than -1 kPa (755 mmHg)
Reference pressure
Less than -4.85 kPa (726 mmHg)
Reference pressure
-1.05 kPa (754 mmHg) or higher
Reference pressure
Not saturated
ES
ES–200
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Reference pressure difference between first and second
0.7 kPa (5.25 mmHg) or more
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to CHECKING MONITOR STATUS (see page ES-15).
ES
ES–201
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Canister Pump Module
ECM
Leak Detection Pump
MGND
MTRB
MPMP
ES
5V
VCC
Canister
Pressure
Sensor
VC
VOUT
PPMP
E2
SGND
Vent Valve
VLVB
VPMP
VGND
Purge VSV
EVP1
MAIN
P/I
EFI
EFI M
MREL
A127933E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
The intelligent tester is required to conduct the following diagnostic troubleshooting procedure.
ES–202
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
HINT:
• Using the intelligent tester monitor results enable the EVAP system to be confirmed.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine conditions
when malfunctions are detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the
vehicle was moving or stationary, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or
rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
CONFIRM DTC
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
Turn the power switch OFF and wait for 10 seconds.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the power switch OFF and wait for 10 seconds.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(g) Check if DTC P0446 is output.
ES
NO
Go to step 5
YES
2
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK
(a) Note the freeze frame data and DTCs.
(b) Clear DTCs.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK / EVAP SYS CHECK / AUTO
OPERATION.
(d) After the system check is finished, check for pending
DTCs.
OK:
No DTC is present.
NG
Go to step 6
OK
3
CHECK OPERATION FOR PRESSURE SWITCHING VALVE
(a) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / TANK BYPASS VSV.
(b) Touch the pressure switching valve (TANK BYPASS
VSV) to feel the operating vibration.
OK:
The pressure switching valve is operated by the
ACTIVE TEST.
NG
OK
Go to step 18
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
4
ES–203
CHECK PRESSURE SWITCHING VALVE
Air
Turn the power switch OFF.
Remove the pressure switching valve (see page EC-31).
Reconnect the pressure switching valve connector.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / TANK BYPASS VSV.
(e) Check the airflow for the pressure switching valve.
OK:
The pressure switching valve operates normally.
Air
E
F
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
E
F
VSV is ON
VSV is OFF
A087973E01
5
NG
Go to step 19
OK
Go to step 33
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK
(a) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK / EVAP SYS CHECK / AUTO
OPERATION.
(b) After the system check is finished, check for pending
DTCs.
OK:
DTCs are present.
NG
CHECK INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
OK
6
CHECK DTC
(a) Check the DTCs that were present at the EVAP system
check.
OK:
P043E, P043F, P2401, P2402 and P2419 are present.
NG
Go to step 10
OK
7
CHECK VENT VALVE CLOSE STUCK
(a) Allow the engine to idle.
(b) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / EVAP VSV.
(c) Turn the EVAP VSV ON (purge VSV open) and check
the VAPOR PRESS (EVAP pressure) for 10 seconds.
OK:
EVAP pressure is higher than 755 mmHg.
NG
Go to step 20
ES
ES–204
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
OK
8
CHECK LEAK DETECTION PUMP OPERATION
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / VACUUM PUMP.
(d) Touch the pump module to feel the operating vibration.
OK:
The leak detection pump is operated by the
ACTIVE TEST.
ES
NG
Go to step 21
OK
9
CHECK TRAP CANISTER
(a) Disconnect the vent hose from the pump module.
(b) Check that no moisture is in the pump module or the
vent hose.
OK:
No moisture.
OK
Go to step 22
NG
Go to step 23
A135512
10
CHECK DTC
(a) Check the DTCs that were present at the EVAP system
check.
OK:
P0441, P0455 and/or P0456 are present.
NG
Go to step 16
OK
11
CHECK INSTALLATION FOR FUEL CAP
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Remove the fuel cap.
Reinstall the fuel cap.
Clear DTCs.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK / EVAP SYS CHECK / AUTO
OPERATION.
(e) After the system check is finished, check for pending
DTCs.
ES–205
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
HINT:
If no DTC is present, this indicates that the fuel cap is
loosened.
OK:
No DTC is present.
OK
REPAIR COMPLETED
NG
12
LOCATE LEAK POINT
(a) Disconnect the vent hose (fresh air line) as shown in the
illustration.
Canister Filter
Vent Hose to Canister
Vent Hose
Adapter
EVAP Tester
A131407E01
(b) Connect the pressure gauge and air pump as shown in
the illustration.
(c) Pressurize the EVAP system until 24 to 28 mmHg.
(d) Locate the leak point.
HINT:
If the EVAP system has leakage, a whistling sound may
be heard.
OK:
The leak point is found.
OK
Go to step 24
NG
13
CHECK FUEL CAP
Check that the fuel cap meets OEM specifications.
HINT:
If an EVAP tester is available, perform the fuel cap test
according to the tester's instructions.
OK:
Fuel cap meets OEM specifications.
NG
Go to step 25
ES
ES–206
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
OK
14
CHECK OPERATION FOR PURGE VSV
(a) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / EVAP VSV.
(b) Touch the purge VSV to feel the operating vibration.
OK:
The purge VSV (EVAP VSV) is operated by the
ACTIVE TEST.
ES
NG
Go to step 26
OK
15
CHECK INTAKE MANIFOLD PRESSURE
(a) Disconnect the purge VSV hose that is connected to the
throttle body.
(b) Allow the engine to idle.
(c) Check that the hose has suction using your finger.
OK:
The hose has suction.
Purge VSV
Hose (to Intake Manifold)
A130450E01
16
NG
Go to step 27
OK
Go to step 28
CHECK DTC
(a) Check the DTCs that were present at the EVAP system
check.
OK:
P0451 is not present.
NG
Go to step 9
OK
17
CHECK OPERATION FOR VENT VALVE
(a) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / VENT VALVE.
(b) Touch the pump module to feel the operating vibration.
OK:
The vent valve is operated by the ACTIVE TEST.
OK
Go to step 9
NG
Go to step 29
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
18
ES–207
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (PRESSURE SWITCHING VALVE - ECM AND EFI M
RELAY)
Wire Harness Side
Pressure Switching Valve Connector
(a) Check the harness and the connectors between the
pressure switching valve and the ECM.
(1) Disconnect the V8 pressure switching valve
connector.
V8
Front View
ES
A072890E04
(2) Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
(3) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E7
TBP
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V8-1 (Pressure switching valve) - E718 (TBP)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
ECM Connector
A065744E70
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V8-1 (Pressure switching valve) or
E7-18 (TBP) - Body ground
10 kΩ higher
(4) Reconnect the pressure switching valve connector.
(5) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(b) Check the harness and the connectors between the
pressure switching valve and the EFI M relay.
(1) Disconnect the V8 pressure switching valve
connector.
(2) Remove the integration relay from the engine room
relay block.
(3) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connector.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
8 3I
Engine Room Relay Block
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V8-2 (Pressure switching valve) - 3I-8
(EFI M relay)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
A082810E01
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V8-2 (Pressure switching valve) or 3I8 (EFI M relay) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(4) Reconnect the pressure switching valve connector.
(5) Reinstall the integration relay.
NG
Go to step 30
OK
Go to step 31
ES–208
19
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
REPLACE PRESSURE SWITCHING VALVE
Replace the pressure switching valve (see page EC-31).
NEXT
20
Go to step 34
CHECK FOR VENT HOSE CLOG
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the vent hose (fresh air line) as shown in the
illustration.
(c) Allow the engine to idle.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / EVAP VSV.
(e) Turn the purge VSV (EVAP VSV) ON and check the
EVAP pressure (VAPOR PRESS) for 10 seconds.
OK:
EVAP pressure is higher than 755 mmHg.
ES
A135512
21
NG
Go to step 22
OK
Go to step 32
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (LEAK DETECTION PUMP - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the V7 canister connector
Wire Harness Side
V7
MTRB
Canister
Connector
MGND
Front View
A085258E49
(b) Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E7
MPMP
ECM Connector
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V7-1 (MTRB) - E7-13 (MPMP)
Below 1 Ω
V7-6 (MGND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
A065744E71
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V7-1 (MTRB) or E7-13 (MPMP) - Body
ground
10 kΩ higher
(d) Reconnect the canister connector.
(e) Reconnect the ECM connector.
ES–209
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
22
NG
Go to step 30
OK
Go to step 31
REPLACE TRAP CANISTER WITH PUMP MODULE
Replace the trap canister with pump module (see page EC17).
NEXT
23
Go to step 34
ES
CHECK FOR VENT HOSE DAMAGE
Check for hose damage as shown in the illustration. If
necessary, replace the vent hose.
Vent Hose
Inspection Area*
Canister Filter
Vent Hose
Air Inlet Port
*: Check for disconnection and/or crack
A130304E01
NEXT
Go to step 22
ES–210
24
25
ES
26
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
REPAIR OR REPLACE LEAK POINT
NEXT
Go to step 34
NEXT
Go to step 34
REPLACE FUEL CAP
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (PURGE VSV - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the V1 purge VSV connector.
Wire Harness Side
Purge VSV
Connector
V1
Front View
A052933E24
(b) Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
(c) Check the harness and the connectors between the
ECM and the purge VSV connectors.
(1) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connector.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E5
ECM Connector
EVP1
A065745E73
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V1-1 - E5-14 (EVP1)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V1-1 or E5-14 (EVP1) - Body ground
10 kΩ higher
(d) Remove the integration relay from the engine room relay
block.
(e) Check the harness and connectors between the purge
VSV connector and the EFI M relay.
(1) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
8 3I
Engine Room Relay Block
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V1-2 - 3I-8 (EFI M relay)
Below 1 Ω
A082810E01
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V1-2 or 3I-8 (EFI M relay) - Body
ground
10 kΩ higher
(f) Reconnect the purge VSV connector.
(g) Reconnect the ECM connector.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–211
(h) Reinstall the integration relay.
27
NG
Go to step 30
OK
Go to step 31
REPLACE HOSE (PURGE VSV - THROTTLE BODY)
NEXT
28
Go to step 34
REPLACE PURGE VSV
Replace the purge VSV (see page EC-23).
NEXT
29
Go to step 34
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (VENT VALVE - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the V7 canister connector.
Wire Harness Side
VLVB
V7
Canister
Connector
Front View
VGND
A085258E50
(b) Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
(c) Check the harness and the connectors between the
ECM and the canister connectors.
(1) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connector.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E7
VPMP
ECM Connector
A065744E72
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V7-8 (VGND) - E7-26 (VPMP)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V7-8 (VGND) or E7-26 (VPMP) - Body
ground
10 kΩ higher
ES
ES–212
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(d) Remove the integration relay from the engine room relay
block.
(e) Check the harness and connectors between the canister
connector and the EFI M relay.
(1) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
8 3I
Engine Room Relay Block
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V7-9 (VLVB) - 3I-8 (EFI M relay)
Below 1 Ω
A082810E01
Standard resistance (Check for short)
ES
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V7-9 (VLVB) or 3I-8 (EFI M relay) Body ground
10 kΩ higher
(f) Reconnect the canister connector.
(g) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(h) Reinstall the integration relay.
30
NG
Go to step 30
OK
Go to step 31
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
NEXT
31
Go to step 34
REPLACE ECM
Replace the ECM (see page ES-469).
NEXT
32
CHECK AND REPLACE VENT HOSE OR CANISTER FILTER
NEXT
33
Go to step 34
Go to step 34
REPLACE HOSE (PRESSURE SWITCHING VALVE AND FUEL TANK)
NEXT
34
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK / EVAP SYS CHECK / AUTO
OPERATION.
(c) After the system check is finished, check for pending
DTCs.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–213
OK:
No DTC is present.
NG
Go to step 6
OK
35
PERFORM EVAP MONITOR DRIVE PATTERN
(a) Check that the following conditions are met:
• Fuel level is 1/8 to 7/8.
• Engine coolant temperature (ECT) is 4.4 to 35°C (40
to 95°F).
• Intake air temperature (IAT) is 4.4 to 35°C (40 to
95°F).
• Difference of ECT and IAT is less than 7°C (13°F).
(b) Enter the check mode. Enter the following menus:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / CHECK MODE.
(c) Allow the engine to idle until the ECT is 75°C (167°F).
(d) Drive the vehicle at 50 km/h (30 mph) or faster and
maintain that speed for 60 seconds or more.
(e) Stop the vehicle. Do not turn the power switch OFF.
(f) Check that the EVAP monitor status is complete. Enter
the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II /
MONITOR STATUS.
(g) If the EVAP monitor is incomplete, drive the vehicle at 50
km/h (30 mph) or faster and maintain that speed for 120
seconds or more. After that, recheck the EVAP monitor
status.
(h) Check for pending DTCs.
OK:
No DTC is present.
NG
OK
REPAIR COMPLETED
Go to step 2
ES
ES–214
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0441
Evaporative Emission Control System Incorrect
Purge Flow
DTC SUMMARY
DTC No.
ES
P0441
P0441
P0441
Monitoring Items
Purge Vacuum
Switching Valve
(VSV) stuck open
Purge VSV stuck
closed
Purge flow
Malfunction
Detection
Conditions
Leak detection pump
creates negative
pressure (vacuum) in
EVAP system and
EVAP system
pressure measured.
0.02 inch leak
criterion measured at
start and at end of
leak check.
If stabilized pressure
higher than [second
0.02 inch leak
criterion x 0.15], ECM
determines that
purge VSV stuck
open.
After EVAP leak
check performed,
purge VSV turned
ON (open), and
atmospheric air
introduced into EVAP
system. 0.02 inch
leak criterion
measured at start
and at end of leak
check.
If pressure does not
return to near
atmospheric
pressure, ECM
determines that
purge VSV stuck
closed.
While engine running,
following conditions
are met:
• Negative
pressure not
created in EVAP
system when
purge VSV
turned ON (open)
• Atmospheric
pressure change
before and after
purge flow
monitor less than
0.93 kPa (7
mmHg)
Trouble Areas
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Detection Timing
Detection Logic
Purge VSV
Connector/wire
harness
(purge VSV ECM)
ECM
Canister pump
module
Leakage from
EVAP system
While power switch
OFF
2 trip
Purge VSV
Connector/wire
harness
(purge VSV ECM)
ECM
Canister pump
module
Leakage from
EVAP system
While power switch
OFF
2 trip
Purge VSV
Connector/wire
harness
(purge VSV ECM)
Leakage from
EVAP line
(purge VSV Intake manifold)
ECM
While engine running
2 trip
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–215
DESCRIPTION
NOTICE:
In this vehicle's EVAP system, turning ON the vent valve does not seal off the EVAP system. To
check for leaks in the EVAP system, disconnect the air inlet vent hose and apply pressure from
the atmosphere side of the canister.
While the engine is running, if a predetermined condition (closed loop, etc.) is met, the purge VSV is
opened by the ECM and stored fuel vapors in the canister are purged to the intake manifold. The ECM
changes the duty cycle ratio of the purge VSV to control purge flow volume.
The purge flow volume is also determined by the intake manifold pressure. Atmospheric pressure is
allowed into the canister through the vent valve to ensure that the purge flow is maintained when the
negative pressure (vacuum) is applied to the canister.
Key-off monitor
This monitor checks for Evaporative Emission (EVAP) system leaks and canister pump module
malfunctions. The monitor starts 5 hours* after the power switch is turned OFF. More than 5 hours are
required to allow the fuel to cool down to stabilize the Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP), thus making the EVAP
system monitor more accurate.
The leak detection pump creates negative pressure (vacuum) in the EVAP system and the pressure is
measured. Finally, the ECM monitors for leaks from the EVAP system and malfunctions in both the
canister pump module and purge VSV, based on the EVAP pressure.
HINT:
*: If the engine coolant temperature is not below 35°C (95°F) 5 hours after the power switch is turned OFF,
the monitor check starts 2 hours later. If it is still not below 35°C (95°F) 7 hours after the power switch is
turned OFF, the monitor check starts 2.5 hours later.
ES
ES–216
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Location
EVAP Hose (From Canister)
Purge Line
ES
EVAP Hose (To Intake Manifold)
Purge VSV
Pump Module
Trap Canister
- Leak Detection Pump
- Canister Pressure Sensor
- Vent Valve
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor
Pressure Switching Valve
Canister Filter
Canister
Fuel Tank
Air Inlet Port
Fuel Cap
A131350E01
ES–217
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Diagram
Intake Manifold
Purge VSV
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor
Fuel Cap
Pressure Switching Valve
Fresh Air Line
ES
Canister
Fuel Pump Chamber
Canister Filter
Bladder Tank
Trap Canister with Pump Module
Outer Tank
Roll Over Valve
A130305E01
Pump Module
: Air Flow
Vent Valve (ON)
From
Canister
Filter
Trap Canister
Vent Valve (OFF)
Reference Orifice
Pressure Sensor
Leak Detection Pump (OFF)
Leak Detection Pump (ON)
A131438E01
ES–218
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Canister Pressure Sensor Specification
Malfunction Area
Output Voltage
4.900 V
4.150 V
Usable Range
ES
1.425 V
Malfunction Area
0.450 V
60 kPa
110 kPa
(450 mmHg) (825 mmHg)
Pressure
HINT:
Standard atmospheric pressure is 101.3 kPa (760mmHg)
A115543E09
Components
Operations
Canister, Trap canister
Contains activated charcoal to absorb EVAP generated in fuel tank.
Cut-off valve
Located in fuel tank. Valve floats and closes when fuel tank 100% full.
Purge Vacuum Switching Valve (VSV)
Opens or closes line between canister and intake manifold. ECM uses
purge VSV to control EVAP purge flow. In order to discharge EVAP
absorbed by canister to intake manifold, ECM opens purge VSV.
EVAP discharge volume to intake manifold controlled by purge VSV
duty cycle ratio (current-carrying time) (open: ON; closed: OFF).
Roll-over valve
Located in fuel tank. Valve closes by its own weight when vehicle
overturns to prevent fuel from spilling out.
Soak timer
Built into ECM. To ensure accurate EVAP monitor, measures 5 hours
(+-15 min) after power switch OFF. This allows fuel to cool down,
stabilizing Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP). When approximately 5 hours
elapsed, ECM activates.
Pressure switching valve
The pressure switching valve located on the canister is used to detect
leakage from the bladder tank into the fuel tank. The valve opens
during the bladder tank leak check. Then, the fuel tank's fuel vapor
flows to the intake manifold without passing the canister.
Pump module
Consists of (a) to (d) below. Pump module cannot be disassembled.
(a) Vent valve
Vents and closes EVAP system. When ECM turns valve ON, EVAP
system closed. When ECM turns valve OFF, EVAP system vented.
Negative pressure (vacuum) created in EVAP system to check for
EVAP leaks by closing purge VSV, turning vent valve ON (closed) and
operating leak detection pump (refer to fig. 1).
(b) Canister pressure sensor
Indicates pressure as voltage. ECM supplies regulated 5 V to canister
pressure sensor, and uses feedback from sensor to monitor EVAP
system pressure (refer to fig. 2).
(c) Leak detection pump
Creates negative pressure (vacuum) in EVAP system for leak check.
ES–219
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Components
Operations
Has opening with 0.02 inch diameter. Vacuum produced through
orifice by closing purge VSV, turning vent valve OFF and operating
leak detection pump to monitor 0.02 inch leak criterion. 0.02 inch leak
criterion indicates small leak of EVAP.
(d) Reference orifice
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
1. Key-off monitor
5 hours* after the power switch is turned OFF, the leak detection pump creates negative pressure
(vacuum) in the EVAP system. The ECM monitors for leaks and actuator malfunctions based on the
EVAP pressure.
HINT:
*: If the engine coolant temperature is not below 35°C (95°F) 5 hours after the power switch is turned
OFF, the monitor check starts 2 hours later. If it is still not below 35°C (95°F) 7 hours after the power
switch is turned OFF, the monitor check starts 2.5 hours later.
Sequence
Descriptions
Duration
ECM activation
Activated by soak timer 5, 7 or 9.5
hours after power switch OFF.
-
Atmospheric pressure
measurement
Vent valve turned OFF (vent) and
EVAP system pressure measured
by ECM in order to register
atmospheric pressure.
If pressure in EVAP system not
between 70 kPa and 110 kPa
(525 mmHg and 825 mmHg),
ECM cancels EVAP system
monitor.
10 seconds
First 0.02 inch leak criterion
measurement
In order to determine 0.02 inch
leak criterion, leak detection
pump creates negative pressure
(vacuum) through reference
orifice and then ECM checks if
leak detection pump and vent
valve operate normally.
60 seconds
EVAP system pressure
measurement
Vent valve turned ON (closed) to
shut EVAP system.
Negative pressure (vacuum)
created in EVAP system, and
EVAP system pressure then
measured.
Write down measured value as it
will be used in leak check.
If EVAP pressure does not
stabilize within 900 seconds,
ECM cancels EVAP system
monitor.
900 seconds*
Purge VSV monitor
Purge VSV opened and then
EVAP system pressure measured
by ECM.
Large increase indicates normal.
10 seconds
E
Second 0.02 inch leak criterion
measurement
After second 0.02 inch leak
criterion measurement, leak
check performed by comparing
first and second 0.02 inch leak
criterion.
If stabilized system pressure
higher than second 0.02 inch leak
criterion, ECM determines that
EVAP system leaking.
60 seconds
-
Final check
Atmospheric pressure measured
and then monitoring result
recorded by ECM.
-
-
A
B
C
D
Operations
ES
ES–220
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
*: If only a small amount of fuel is in the fuel tank, it takes longer for the EVAP pressure to stabilize.
Operation A: Atmospheric Pressure Measurement
Purge VSV: OFF
Canister
Fuel Tank
Vent Valve: OFF (vent)
ES
Reference
Orifice
Canister
Pressure
Sensor
Operation B, E: 0.02 Inch Leak
Criterion Measurement
OFF
OFF (vent)
Canister Pump Module
Canister Filter
ON
Leak Detection Pump: OFF
Operation C: EVAP System Pressure Measurement
OFF
ON
ON (closed)
Atmospheric
Pressure
Negative
Pressure
Operation D: Purge VSV Monitor
ON
ON (closed)
ON
A122912E01
ES–221
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(a)Purge VSV stuck open
In operation C, the leak detection pump creates negative pressure (vacuum) in the EVAP system.
The EVAP system pressure is then measured by the ECM using the canister pressure sensor. If the
stabilized system pressure is higher than [second 0.02 inch leak criterion x 0.15], the ECM interprets
this as the purge Vacuum Switching Valve (VSV) being stuck open. The ECM illuminates the MIL
and sets the DTC (2 trip detection logic).
EVAP Pressure when Purge VSV Stuck Open
ON: Open
ON
Purge VSV
OFF: Closed
ON: Closed
ON
Vent Valve
OFF: Vent
Leak Detection
Pump
ON
EVAP Pressure
Malfunction
Positive
Negative
0.02 Inch
Leak Criterion
OK
Sequence
A
B
C
D
E
Time (Second)
10
60
Within 900
10
60
A135977E01
ES
ES–222
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(b)Purge VSV stuck closed
In operation D, the canister pressure sensor measures the EVAP system pressure. The pressure
measurement for the purge VSV monitor begins when the purge VSV is turned ON (open) after the
EVAP leak check. When the measured pressure indicates an increase of 0.3 kPa (2.25 mmHg) or
more, the purge VSV is functioning normally. If the pressure does not increase, the ECM interprets
this as the purge VSV being stuck closed. The ECM illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC (2 trip
detection logic).
EVAP Pressure when Purge VSV Stuck Closed
ON
Purge VSV
ES
ON: Open
OFF: Closed
ON: Closed
ON
Vent Valve
Leak Detection
Pump
OFF: Vent
ON
EVAP Pressure
OK
Positive
Negative
Malfunction
0.02 Inch
Leak Criterion
Sequence
A
B
C
D
E
Time (Second)
10
60
Within 900
10
60
A106059E04
(c) Purge flow
While the engine running, the purge VSV opens to purge the fuel vapor according to the engine
condition. The ECM check the EVAP pressure when the purge VSV opens.
If the pressure dose not change, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction. The ECM illuminates the
MIL and sets DTC (2 trip detection logic).
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0441: Purge VSV stuck open
P0441: Purge VSV stuck closed
P0441: Purge flow
Required Sensors/Components
Purge VSV and canister pump module
Frequency of Operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
Maximum 15 seconds
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
Purge Flow Monitor:
Monitor runs whenever following DTC not present
-
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Engine
Running
ECT
4.4°C (40°F) or more
IAT
4.4°C (40°F) or more
EVAP control system pressure sensor malfunction
Not detected
Purge VSV
Not detected by scan tool
EVAP system check
Not detected by scan tool
Battery voltage
11 V or higher
Purge duty cycle
15% or more
ES–223
Purge VSV Stuck:
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
P0011, P0012, P0021, P0022 (VVT system-Advance, Retard)
P0100, P0101, P0102, P0103 (MAF sensor)
P0110, P0112, P0113 (IAT sensor)
P0115, P0116, P0117, P0118 (ECT sensor)
P0120, P0122, P0123, P0220, P0222, P0223, P2135,(TP sensor)
P0125 (Insufficient ECT for closed loop)
P0171, P0172, P0174, P0175 (Fuel system)
P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303, P0304 (Misfire)
P0335 (CKP sensor)
P0340, P0341 (CMP sensor)
P0351, P0352, P0353, P0354 (Igniter)
P0450, P0452, P0453 (EVAP press sensor)
P0500 (VSS)
Atmospheric pressure
70 to 110 kPa (525 to 825 mmHg)
Battery voltage
10.5 V or higher
Vehicle speed
Less than 4 km/h (2.5 mph)
Power switch
OFF
Time after key off
5 or 7 or 9.5 hours
Purge VSV
Not operated by scan tool
Vent valve
Not operated by scan tool
Leak detection pump
Not operated by scan tool
Both of the following conditions 1 and 2 are met before key off
-
1. Duration that vehicle has been driven
5 minutes or more
2. EVAP purge operation
Performed
ECT
4.4 to 35°C (40 to 95°F)
IAT
4.4 to 35°C (40 to 95°F)
1. Key-off monitor sequence 1 to 8
1. Atmospheric pressure measurement
Next sequence is run if the following condition is met
-
Atmospheric pressure change
Within 0.3 kPa (2.25 mmHg) in 1 second
2. First reference pressure measurement
Next sequence is run if the following conditions are met
-
EVAP pressure just after reference pressure measurement start
-1 kPa (-7.5 mmHg) or lower
Reference pressure
-4.85 to -1.05 kPa (726 to 754 mmHg)
Reference pressure
Saturated within 60 seconds
3. Vent valve stuck closed check
Next sequence is run if the following condition is met
-
EVAP pressure change after vent valve is ON
0.3 kPa (2.25 mmHg) or more
4. Vacuum introduction
Next sequence is run if the following condition is met
-
EVAP pressure
Saturated within 900 seconds
ES
ES–224
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
5. Purge VSV stuck closed check
Next sequence is run if the following condition is met
-
EVAP pressure change after purge valve is open
0.3 kPa (2.25 mmHg) or more
6. Second reference pressure measurement
Next sequence is run if the following conditions are met
-
EVAP pressure just after reference pressure measurement
-1 kPa (-7.5 mmHg) or lower
Reference pressure
-4.85 to -1.05 kPa (726 to 754 mmHg)
Reference pressure
Saturated within 60 seconds
Reference pressure difference between first and second
Less than 0.7 kPa (5.25 mmHg)
7. Leak check
ES
Next sequence is run if the following condition is met
-
EVAP pressure when vacuum introduction is complete
Lower than second reference pressure
8. Atmospheric pressure measurement
EVAP monitor is complete if the following condition is met
-
Atmospheric pressure difference between sequence 1 and 8
Within 0.3 kPa (2.25 mmHg)
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
"Saturated" indicates that the EVAP pressure change is less than 0.1 kPa (0.75 mmHg) in 30 seconds.
Purge Flow Monitor:
EVAP pressure change when purge flow is started
Lower than 0.93 kPa (7 mmHg)
Key-off Monitor: Purge VSV stuck open
FTP when vacuum introduction complete
Higher than reference pressure x 0.15
Key-off Monitor: Purge VSV stuck closed
FTP change after purge VSV ON (open)
Less than 0.3 kPa (2.25 mmHg)
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to CHECKING MONITOR STATUS (see page ES-15).
ES–225
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Canister Pump Module
ECM
Leak Detection Pump
MGND
MTRB
MPMP
ES
5V
VCC
Canister
Pressure
Sensor
VC
VOUT
PPMP
E2
SGND
Vent Valve
VLVB
VPMP
VGND
Purge VSV
EVP1
MAIN
P/I
EFI
EFI M
MREL
A127933E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
The intelligent tester is required to conduct the following diagnostic troubleshooting procedure.
ES–226
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
HINT:
• Using the intelligent tester monitor results enable the EVAP system to be confirmed.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine conditions
when malfunctions are detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the
vehicle was moving or stationary, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or
rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
CONFIRM DTC
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
Turn the power switch OFF and wait for 10 seconds.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the power switch OFF and wait for 10 seconds.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(g) Check if DTC P0446 is output.
ES
NO
Go to step 5
YES
2
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK
(a) Note the freeze frame data and DTCs.
(b) Clear DTCs.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK / EVAP SYS CHECK / AUTO
OPERATION.
(d) After the system check is finished, check for pending
DTCs.
OK:
No DTC is present.
NG
Go to step 6
OK
3
CHECK OPERATION FOR PRESSURE SWITCHING VALVE
(a) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / TANK BYPASS VSV.
(b) Touch the pressure switching valve (TANK BYPASS
VSV) to feel the operating vibration.
OK:
The pressure switching valve is operated by the
ACTIVE TEST.
NG
OK
Go to step 18
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
4
ES–227
CHECK PRESSURE SWITCHING VALVE
Air
Turn the power switch OFF.
Remove the pressure switching valve (see page EC-31).
Reconnect the pressure switching valve connector.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / TANK BYPASS VSV.
(e) Check the airflow for the pressure switching valve.
OK:
The pressure switching valve operates normally.
Air
E
F
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
E
F
VSV is ON
VSV is OFF
A087973E01
5
NG
Go to step 19
OK
Go to step 33
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK
(a) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK / EVAP SYS CHECK / AUTO
OPERATION.
(b) After the system check is finished, check for pending
DTCs.
OK:
DTCs are present.
NG
CHECK INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
OK
6
CHECK DTC
(a) Check the DTCs that were present at the EVAP system
check.
OK:
P043E, P043F, P2401, P2402 and P2419 are present.
NG
Go to step 10
OK
7
CHECK VENT VALVE CLOSE STUCK
(a) Allow the engine to idle.
(b) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / EVAP VSV.
(c) Turn the EVAP VSV ON (purge VSV open) and check
the VAPOR PRESS (EVAP pressure) for 10 seconds.
OK:
EVAP pressure is higher than 755 mmHg.
NG
Go to step 20
ES
ES–228
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
OK
8
CHECK LEAK DETECTION PUMP OPERATION
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / VACUUM PUMP.
(d) Touch the pump module to feel the operating vibration.
OK:
The leak detection pump is operated by the
ACTIVE TEST.
ES
NG
Go to step 21
OK
9
CHECK TRAP CANISTER
(a) Disconnect the vent hose from the pump module.
(b) Check that no moisture is in the pump module or the
vent hose.
OK:
No moisture.
OK
Go to step 22
NG
Go to step 23
A135512
10
CHECK DTC
(a) Check the DTCs that were present at the EVAP system
check.
OK:
P0441, P0455 and/or P0456 are present.
NG
Go to step 16
OK
11
CHECK INSTALLATION FOR FUEL CAP
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Remove the fuel cap.
Reinstall the fuel cap.
Clear DTCs.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK / EVAP SYS CHECK / AUTO
OPERATION.
(e) After the system check is finished, check for pending
DTCs.
ES–229
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
HINT:
If no DTC is present, this indicates that the fuel cap is
loosened.
OK:
No DTC is present.
OK
REPAIR COMPLETED
NG
12
LOCATE LEAK POINT
(a) Disconnect the vent hose (fresh air line) as shown in the
illustration.
Canister Filter
Vent Hose to Canister
Vent Hose
Adapter
EVAP Tester
A131407E01
(b) Connect the pressure gauge and air pump as shown in
the illustration.
(c) Pressurize the EVAP system until 24 to 28 mmHg.
(d) Locate the leak point.
HINT:
If the EVAP system has leakage, a whistling sound may
be heard.
OK:
The leak point is found.
OK
Go to step 24
NG
13
CHECK FUEL CAP
Check that the fuel cap meets OEM specifications.
HINT:
If an EVAP tester is available, perform the fuel cap test
according to the tester's instructions.
OK:
Fuel cap meets OEM specifications.
NG
Go to step 25
ES
ES–230
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
OK
14
CHECK OPERATION FOR PURGE VSV
(a) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / EVAP VSV.
(b) Touch the purge VSV to feel the operating vibration.
OK:
The purge VSV (EVAP VSV) is operated by the
ACTIVE TEST.
ES
NG
Go to step 26
OK
15
CHECK INTAKE MANIFOLD PRESSURE
(a) Disconnect the purge VSV hose that is connected to the
throttle body.
(b) Allow the engine to idle.
(c) Check that the hose has suction using your finger.
OK:
The hose has suction.
Purge VSV
Hose (to Intake Manifold)
A130450E01
16
NG
Go to step 27
OK
Go to step 28
CHECK DTC
(a) Check the DTCs that were present at the EVAP system
check.
OK:
P0451 is not present.
NG
Go to step 9
OK
17
CHECK OPERATION FOR VENT VALVE
(a) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / VENT VALVE.
(b) Touch the pump module to feel the operating vibration.
OK:
The vent valve is operated by the ACTIVE TEST.
OK
Go to step 9
NG
Go to step 29
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
18
ES–231
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (PRESSURE SWITCHING VALVE - ECM AND EFI M
RELAY)
Wire Harness Side
Pressure Switching Valve Connector
(a) Check the harness and the connectors between the
pressure switching valve and the ECM.
(1) Disconnect the V8 pressure switching valve
connector.
V8
Front View
ES
A072890E04
(2) Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
(3) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E7
TBP
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V8-1 (Pressure switching valve) - E718 (TBP)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
ECM Connector
A065744E70
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V8-1 (Pressure switching valve) or
E7-18 (TBP) - Body ground
10 kΩ higher
(4) Reconnect the pressure switching valve connector.
(5) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(b) Check the harness and the connectors between the
pressure switching valve and the EFI M relay.
(1) Disconnect the V8 pressure switching valve
connector.
(2) Remove the integration relay from the engine room
relay block.
(3) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connector.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
8 3I
Engine Room Relay Block
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V8-2 (Pressure switching valve) - 3I-8
(EFI M relay)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
A082810E01
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V8-2 (Pressure switching valve) or 3I8 (EFI M relay) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(4) Reconnect the pressure switching valve connector.
(5) Reinstall the integration relay.
NG
Go to step 30
OK
Go to step 31
ES–232
19
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
REPLACE PRESSURE SWITCHING VALVE
Replace the pressure switching valve (see page EC-31).
NEXT
20
Go to step 34
CHECK FOR VENT HOSE CLOG
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the vent hose (fresh air line) as shown in the
illustration.
(c) Allow the engine to idle.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / EVAP VSV.
(e) Turn the purge VSV (EVAP VSV) ON and check the
EVAP pressure (VAPOR PRESS) for 10 seconds.
OK:
EVAP pressure is higher than 755 mmHg.
ES
A135512
21
NG
Go to step 22
OK
Go to step 32
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (LEAK DETECTION PUMP - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the V7 canister connector
Wire Harness Side
V7
MTRB
Canister
Connector
MGND
Front View
A085258E49
(b) Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E7
MPMP
ECM Connector
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V7-1 (MTRB) - E7-13 (MPMP)
Below 1 Ω
V7-6 (MGND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
A065744E71
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V7-1 (MTRB) or E7-13 (MPMP) - Body
ground
10 kΩ higher
(d) Reconnect the canister connector.
(e) Reconnect the ECM connector.
ES–233
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
22
NG
Go to step 30
OK
Go to step 31
REPLACE TRAP CANISTER WITH PUMP MODULE
Replace the trap canister with pump module (see page EC17).
NEXT
23
Go to step 34
ES
CHECK FOR VENT HOSE DAMAGE
Check for hose damage as shown in the illustration. If
necessary, replace the vent hose.
Vent Hose
Inspection Area*
Canister Filter
Vent Hose
Air Inlet Port
*: Check for disconnection and/or crack
A130304E01
NEXT
Go to step 22
ES–234
24
25
ES
26
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
REPAIR OR REPLACE LEAK POINT
NEXT
Go to step 34
NEXT
Go to step 34
REPLACE FUEL CAP
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (PURGE VSV - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the V1 purge VSV connector.
Wire Harness Side
Purge VSV
Connector
V1
Front View
A052933E24
(b) Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
(c) Check the harness and the connectors between the
ECM and the purge VSV connectors.
(1) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connector.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E5
ECM Connector
EVP1
A065745E73
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V1-1 - E5-14 (EVP1)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V1-1 or E5-14 (EVP1) - Body ground
10 kΩ higher
(d) Remove the integration relay from the engine room relay
block.
(e) Check the harness and connectors between the purge
VSV connector and the EFI M relay.
(1) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
8 3I
Engine Room Relay Block
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V1-2 - 3I-8 (EFI M relay)
Below 1 Ω
A082810E01
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V1-2 or 3I-8 (EFI M relay) - Body
ground
10 kΩ higher
(f) Reconnect the purge VSV connector.
(g) Reconnect the ECM connector.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–235
(h) Reinstall the integration relay.
27
NG
Go to step 30
OK
Go to step 31
REPLACE HOSE (PURGE VSV - THROTTLE BODY)
NEXT
28
Go to step 34
REPLACE PURGE VSV
Replace the purge VSV (see page EC-23).
NEXT
29
Go to step 34
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (VENT VALVE - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the V7 canister connector.
Wire Harness Side
VLVB
V7
Canister
Connector
Front View
VGND
A085258E50
(b) Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
(c) Check the harness and the connectors between the
ECM and the canister connectors.
(1) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connector.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E7
VPMP
ECM Connector
A065744E72
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V7-8 (VGND) - E7-26 (VPMP)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V7-8 (VGND) or E7-26 (VPMP) - Body
ground
10 kΩ higher
ES
ES–236
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(d) Remove the integration relay from the engine room relay
block.
(e) Check the harness and connectors between the canister
connector and the EFI M relay.
(1) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
8 3I
Engine Room Relay Block
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V7-9 (VLVB) - 3I-8 (EFI M relay)
Below 1 Ω
A082810E01
Standard resistance (Check for short)
ES
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V7-9 (VLVB) or 3I-8 (EFI M relay) Body ground
10 kΩ higher
(f) Reconnect the canister connector.
(g) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(h) Reinstall the integration relay.
30
NG
Go to step 30
OK
Go to step 31
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
NEXT
31
Go to step 34
REPLACE ECM
Replace the ECM (see page ES-469).
NEXT
32
CHECK AND REPLACE VENT HOSE OR CANISTER FILTER
NEXT
33
Go to step 34
Go to step 34
REPLACE HOSE (PRESSURE SWITCHING VALVE AND FUEL TANK)
NEXT
34
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK / EVAP SYS CHECK / AUTO
OPERATION.
(c) After the system check is finished, check for pending
DTCs.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–237
OK:
No DTC is present.
NG
Go to step 6
OK
35
PERFORM EVAP MONITOR DRIVE PATTERN
(a) Check that the following conditions are met:
• Fuel level is 1/8 to 7/8.
• Engine coolant temperature (ECT) is 4.4 to 35°C (40
to 95°F).
• Intake air temperature (IAT) is 4.4 to 35°C (40 to
95°F).
• Difference of ECT and IAT is less than 7°C (13°F).
(b) Enter the check mode. Enter the following menus:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / CHECK MODE.
(c) Allow the engine to idle until the ECT is 75°C (167°F).
(d) Drive the vehicle at 50 km/h (30 mph) or faster and
maintain that speed for 60 seconds or more.
(e) Stop the vehicle. Do not turn the power switch OFF.
(f) Check that the EVAP monitor status is complete. Enter
the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II /
MONITOR STATUS.
(g) If the EVAP monitor is incomplete, drive the vehicle at 50
km/h (30 mph) or faster and maintain that speed for 120
seconds or more. After that, recheck the EVAP monitor
status.
(h) Check for pending DTCs.
OK:
No DTC is present.
NG
OK
REPAIR COMPLETED
Go to step 2
ES
ES–238
DTC
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
P0446
Evaporative Emission Control System Vent
Control Circuit
DESCRIPTION
ES
DTC
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0446
One of the following condition is met while
vehicle is driving (2 trip detection logic):
• No change in fuel tank pressure when
purge VSV and pressure switching valve
are opened
• No change in fuel tank pressure when fuel
tank is depressurized until 740 mmHg
and purge VSV is closed
•
•
•
•
•
Leak from EVAP system
Pressure switching valve
Purge VSV
Vent valve
Fuel tank pressure sensor
This DTC is designed to detect the pressure switching valve (3-way VSV) malfunction. If the malfunction
is detected while the vehicle is running, the ECM illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC (2 detection logic).
The pressure switching valve located on the canister is used to detect leakage from the bladder tank into
the fuel tank. The valve opens during the bladder tank leak check. Then, the fuel tank's fuel vapor flows to
the intake manifold without passing the canister.
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
Pressure switching valve is stuck OFF (Closed)
The pressure switching valve opens when the purge VSV opens while the vehicle is running. Then, the
fuel tank pressure drops 2 mmHg or more when the pressure switching valve is normal. If the pressure
does not change, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction. The ECM illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC
(2 trip detection logic).
Pressure switching valve is stuck ON (Open)
In order to depressurize the fuel tank, the pump module's vent valve is turned ON (close) when the purge
VSV opens while the vehicle is running. After the fuel tank pressure drops 20 mmHg, the purge VSV
closes. Then, the fuel tank pressure rises slightly when the pressure switching valve is normal. If the
pressure rises quickly, the ECM interprets this as a malfunction. The ECM illuminates the MIL and sets a
DTC (2 trip detection logic).
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0466: Pressure switching valve fixed
Required Sensors/Components
Pressure switching valve
Frequency of Operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
Within 10 seconds
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
Monitor runs whenever following DTC not present
P0441: Purge VSV
P1450 - P1453: FTP sensor
Altitude
Less than 2,400 m (8,000 ft.)
Battery voltage
11 V or more
IAT at engine start - ECT at engine start
-7 to 11°C (-12.6 to 20°F)
ECT at engine start
4.4 to 35°C (40 to 95°F)
IAT at engine start
4.4 to 35°C (40 to 95°F)
Vehicle speed
Constant between 45 and 130 km/h (28 and 80 mph)
Time after engine start
Less than 30 minutes
HV ECU
OK
ES–239
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Fail-safe via HV ECU
Not executed
Purge flow volume
0.08 g/sec. or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Either of following condition 1 or 2 is met
-
1. Following conditions are met
-
FTP change when pressure switching valve is ON
0.267 kPa (2 mmHg) or more
FTP
-2.667 kPa (740 mmHg) or higher
FTP increase after 20 mmHg vacuum is applied to fuel tank
1.333 kPa (10 mmHg) or more
WIRING DIAGRAM
ES
ECM
EFI M
Pressure Switching Valve
TPB
EFI
MREL
P/I
MAIN
A130545E01
ES–240
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CONFIRM DTC
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
Turn the power switch OFF and wait for 10 seconds.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the power switch OFF and wait for 10 seconds.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(g) Check if DTC P0446 is output.
ES
NO
Go to step 5
YES
2
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK
(a) Note the freeze frame data and DTCs.
(b) Clear DTCs.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK / EVAP SYS CHECK / AUTO
OPERATION.
(d) After the system check is finished, check for pending
DTCs.
OK:
No DTC is present.
NG
Go to step 6
OK
3
CHECK OPERATION FOR PRESSURE SWITCHING VALVE
(a) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / TANK BYPASS VSV.
(b) Touch the pressure switching valve (TANK BYPASS
VSV) to feel the operating vibration.
OK:
The pressure switching valve is operated by the
ACTIVE TEST.
NG
OK
Go to step 18
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
4
ES–241
CHECK PRESSURE SWITCHING VALVE
Air
Turn the power switch OFF.
Remove the pressure switching valve (see page EC-31).
Reconnect the pressure switching valve connector.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / TANK BYPASS VSV.
(e) Check the airflow for the pressure switching valve.
OK:
The pressure switching valve operates normally.
Air
E
F
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
E
F
VSV is ON
VSV is OFF
A087973E01
5
NG
Go to step 19
OK
Go to step 33
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK
(a) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK / EVAP SYS CHECK / AUTO
OPERATION.
(b) After the system check is finished, check for pending
DTCs.
OK:
DTCs are present.
NG
CHECK INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
OK
6
CHECK DTC
(a) Check the DTCs that were present at the EVAP system
check.
OK:
P043E, P043F, P2401, P2402 and P2419 are present.
NG
Go to step 10
OK
7
CHECK VENT VALVE CLOSE STUCK
(a) Allow the engine to idle.
(b) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / EVAP VSV.
(c) Turn the EVAP VSV ON (purge VSV open) and check
the VAPOR PRESS (EVAP pressure) for 10 seconds.
OK:
EVAP pressure is higher than 755 mmHg.
NG
Go to step 20
ES
ES–242
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
OK
8
CHECK LEAK DETECTION PUMP OPERATION
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / VACUUM PUMP.
(d) Touch the pump module to feel the operating vibration.
OK:
The leak detection pump is operated by the
ACTIVE TEST.
ES
NG
Go to step 21
OK
9
CHECK TRAP CANISTER
(a) Disconnect the vent hose from the pump module.
(b) Check that no moisture is in the pump module or the
vent hose.
OK:
No moisture.
OK
Go to step 22
NG
Go to step 23
A135512
10
CHECK DTC
(a) Check the DTCs that were present at the EVAP system
check.
OK:
P0441, P0455 and/or P0456 are present.
NG
Go to step 16
NG
11
CHECK INSTALLATION FOR FUEL CAP
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Remove the fuel cap.
Reinstall the fuel cap.
Clear DTCs.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK / EVAP SYS CHECK / AUTO
OPERATION.
(e) After the system check is finished, check for pending
DTCs.
ES–243
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
HINT:
If no DTC is present, this indicates that the fuel cap is
loosened.
OK:
No DTC is present.
OK
REPAIR COMPLETED
NG
12
LOCATE LEAK POINT
(a) Disconnect the vent hose (fresh air line) as shown in the
illustration.
Canister Filter
Vent Hose to Canister
Vent Hose
Adapter
EVAP Tester
A131407E01
(b) Connect the pressure gauge and air pump as shown in
the illustration.
(c) Pressurize the EVAP system until 24 to 28 mmHg.
(d) Locate the leak point.
HINT:
If the EVAP system has leakage, a whistling sound may
be heard.
OK:
The leak point is found.
OK
Go to step 24
NG
13
CHECK FUEL CAP
Check that the fuel cap meets OEM specifications.
HINT:
If an EVAP tester is available, perform the fuel cap test
according to the tester's instructions.
OK:
Fuel cap meets OEM specifications.
NG
Go to step 25
ES
ES–244
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
OK
14
CHECK OPERATION FOR PURGE VSV
(a) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / EVAP VSV.
(b) Touch the purge VSV to feel the operating vibration.
OK:
The purge VSV (EVAP VSV) is operated by the
ACTIVE TEST.
ES
NG
Go to step 26
OK
15
CHECK INTAKE MANIFOLD PRESSURE
(a) Disconnect the purge VSV hose that is connected to the
throttle body.
(b) Allow the engine to idle.
(c) Check that the hose has suction using your finger.
OK:
The hose has suction.
Purge VSV
Hose (to Intake Manifold)
A130450E01
16
NG
Go to step 27
OK
Go to step 28
CHECK DTC
(a) Check the DTCs that were present at the EVAP system
check.
OK:
P0451 is not present.
NG
Go to step 9
OK
17
CHECK OPERATION FOR VENT VALVE
(a) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / VENT VALVE.
(b) Touch the pump module to feel the operating vibration.
OK:
The vent valve is operated by the ACTIVE TEST.
OK
Go to step 9
NG
Go to step 29
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
18
ES–245
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (PRESSURE SWITCHING VALVE - ECM AND EFI M
RELAY)
Wire Harness Side
Pressure Switching Valve Connector
(a) Check the harness and the connectors between the
pressure switching valve and the ECM.
(1) Disconnect the V8 pressure switching valve
connector.
V8
Front View
ES
A072890E04
(2) Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
(3) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard resistance Check for open)
E7
TBP
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V8-1 (Pressure switching valve) - E718 (TBP)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
ECM Connector
A065744E70
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V8-1 (Pressure switching valve) or
E7-18 (TBP) - Body ground
10 kΩ higher
(4) Reconnect the pressure switching valve connector.
(5) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(b) Check the harness and the connectors between the
pressure switching valve and the EFI M relay.
(1) Disconnect the V8 pressure switching valve
connector.
(2) Remove the integration relay from the engine room
relay block.
(3) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connector.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
8 3I
Engine Room Relay Block
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V8-2 (Pressure switching valve) - 3I-8
(EFI M relay)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
A082810E01
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V8-2 (Pressure switching valve) or 3I8 (EFI M relay) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(4) Reconnect the pressure switching valve connector.
(5) Reinstall the integration relay.
NG
Go to step 30
OK
Go to step 31
ES–246
19
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
REPLACE PRESSURE SWITCHING VALVE
Replace the pressure switching valve (see page EC-31).
NEXT
20
Go to step 34
CHECK FOR VENT HOSE CLOG
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the vent hose (fresh air line) as shown in the
illustration.
(c) Allow the engine to idle.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / EVAP VSV.
(e) Turn the purge VSV (EVAP VSV) ON and check the
EVAP pressure (VAPOR PRESS) for 10 seconds.
OK:
EVAP pressure is higher than 755 mmHg.
ES
A135512
21
NG
Go to step 22
OK
Go to step 32
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (LEAK DETECTION PUMP - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the V7 canister connector
Wire Harness Side
V7
MTRB
Canister
Connector
MGND
Front View
A085258E49
(b) Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E7
MPMP
ECM Connector
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V7-1 (MTRB) - E7-13 (MPMP)
Below 1 Ω
V7-6 (MGND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
A065744E71
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V7-1 (MTRB) or E7-13 (MPMP) - Body
ground
10 kΩ higher
(d) Reconnect the canister connector.
(e) Reconnect the ECM connector.
ES–247
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
22
NG
Go to step 30
OK
Go to step 31
REPLACE TRAP CANISTER WITH PUMP MODULE
Replace the trap canister with pump module (see page EC17).
NEXT
23
Go to step 34
ES
CHECK FOR VENT HOSE DAMAGE
Check for hose damage as shown in the illustration. If
necessary, replace the vent hose.
Vent Hose
Inspection Area*
Canister Filter
Vent Hose
Air Inlet Port
*: Check for disconnection and/or crack
A130304E01
NEXT
Go to step 22
ES–248
24
25
ES
26
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
REPAIR OR REPLACE LEAK POINT
NEXT
Go to step 34
NEXT
Go to step 34
REPLACE FUEL CAP
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (PURGE VSV - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the V1 purge VSV connector.
Wire Harness Side
Purge VSV
Connector
V1
Front View
A052933E24
(b) Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
(c) Check the harness and the connectors between the
ECM and the purge VSV connectors.
(1) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connector.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E5
ECM Connector
EVP1
A065745E73
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V1-1 - E5-14 (EVP1)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V1-1 or E5-14 (EVP1) - Body ground
10 kΩ higher
(d) Remove the integration relay from the engine room relay
block.
(e) Check the harness and connectors between the purge
VSV connector and the EFI M relay.
(1) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
8 3I
Engine Room Relay Block
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V1-2 - 3I-8 (EFI M relay)
Below 1 Ω
A082810E01
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V1-2 or 3I-8 (EFI M relay) - Body
ground
10 kΩ higher
(f) Reconnect the purge VSV connector.
(g) Reconnect the ECM connector.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–249
(h) Reinstall the integration relay.
27
NG
Go to step 30
OK
Go to step 31
REPLACE HOSE (PURGE VSV - THROTTLE BODY)
NEXT
28
Go to step 34
REPLACE PURGE VSV
Replace the purge VSV (see page EC-23).
NEXT
29
Go to step 34
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (VENT VALVE - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the V7 canister connector.
Wire Harness Side
VLVB
V7
Canister
Connector
Front View
VGND
A085258E50
(b) Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
(c) Check the harness and the connectors between the
ECM and the canister connectors.
(1) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connector.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E7
VPMP
ECM Connector
A065744E72
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V7-8 (VGND) - E7-26 (VPMP)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V7-8 (VGND) or E7-26 (VPMP) - Body
ground
10 kΩ higher
ES
ES–250
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(d) Remove the integration relay from the engine room relay
block.
(e) Check the harness and connectors between the canister
connector and the EFI M relay.
(1) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
8 3I
Engine Room Relay Block
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V7-9 (VLVB) - 3I-8 (EFI M relay)
Below 1 Ω
A082810E01
Standard resistance (Check for short)
ES
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V7-9 (VLVB) or 3I-8 (EFI M relay) Body ground
10 kΩ higher
(f) Reconnect the canister connector.
(g) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(h) Reinstall the integration relay.
30
NG
Go to step 30
OK
Go to step 31
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
NEXT
31
Go to step 34
REPLACE ECM
Replace the ECM (see page ES-469).
NEXT
32
CHECK AND REPLACE VENT HOSE OR CANISTER FILTER
NEXT
33
Go to step 34
Go to step 34
REPLACE HOSE (PRESSURE SWITCHING VALVE AND FUEL TANK)
NEXT
34
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK / EVAP SYS CHECK / AUTO
OPERATION.
(c) After the system check is finished, check for pending
DTCs.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–251
OK:
No DTC is present.
NG
Go to step 6
OK
35
PERFORM EVAP MONITOR DRIVE PATTERN
(a) Check that the following conditions are met:
• Fuel level is 1/8 to 7/8.
• Engine coolant temperature (ECT) is 4.4 to 35°C (40
to 95°F).
• Intake air temperature (IAT) is 4.4 to 35°C (40 to
95°F).
• Difference of ECT and IAT is less than 7°C (13°F).
(b) Enter the check mode. Enter the following menus:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / CHECK MODE.
(c) Allow the engine to idle until the ECT is 75°C (167°F).
(d) Drive the vehicle at 50 km/h (30 mph) or faster and
maintain that speed for 60 seconds or more.
(e) Stop the vehicle. Do not turn the power switch OFF.
(f) Check that the EVAP monitor status is complete. Enter
the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II /
MONITOR STATUS.
(g) If the EVAP monitor is incomplete, drive the vehicle at 50
km/h (30 mph) or faster and maintain that speed for 120
seconds or more. After that, recheck the EVAP monitor
status.
(h) Check for pending DTCs.
OK:
No DTC is present.
NG
OK
REPAIR COMPLETED
Go to step 2
ES
ES–252
ES
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0450
Evaporative Emission Control System Pressure
Sensor Malfunction
DTC
P0451
Evaporative Emission Control System Pressure
Sensor Range / Performance
DTC
P0452
Evaporative Emission Control System Pressure
Sensor / Switch Low Input
DTC
P0453
Evaporative Emission Control System Pressure
Sensor / Switch High Input
DTC SUMMARY
DTC No.
P0450
Monitoring Items
Malfunction
Detection
Conditions
Canister pressure
sensor voltage
abnormal fluctuation
Sensor output
voltage rapidly
fluctuates beyond
upper and lower
malfunction
thresholds for 0.5
seconds.
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
•
P0451
Canister pressure
sensor noisy
Sensor output
voltage fluctuates
frequently in certain
time period.
•
•
•
P0451
Canister pressure
sensor stuck
Sensor output
voltage does not vary
in certain time period.
•
•
P0452
Canister pressure
sensor voltage low
Sensor output
voltage less than
0.45 V for 0.5
seconds.
•
•
•
P0453
Canister pressure
sensor voltage high
Sensor output
voltage more than 4.9
V for 0.5 seconds.
Detection Timing
•
•
Canister pump
module
ECM
Canister pump
module
EVAP system
hose (pipe from
air inlet port to
canister pump
module, canister
filter, fuel tank
vent hose)
ECM
Canister pump
module
EVAP system
hose (pipe from
air inlet port to
canister pump
module, canister
filter, fuel tank
vent hose)
ECM
Canister pump
module
Connector/wire
harness (canister
pump module ECM)
ECM
Canister pump
module
Connector/wire
harness (canister
pump module ECM)
ECM
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Detection logic
EVAP monitoring
(power switch
OFF)
Power switch ON
(IG)
1 trip
EVAP monitoring
(power switch
OFF)
Engine running
2 trip
EVAP monitoring
(power switch
OFF)
2 trip
EVAP monitoring
(power switch
OFF)
Power switch ON
(IG)
1 trip
EVAP monitoring
(power switch
OFF)
Power switch ON
(IG)
1 trip
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–253
HINT:
The canister pressure sensor is built into the canister pump module.
DESCRIPTION
NOTICE:
In this vehicle's EVAP system, turning ON the vent valve does not seal off the EVAP system. To
check for leaks in the EVAP system, disconnect the air inlet vent hose and apply pressure from
the atmosphere side of the canister.
While the engine is running, if a predetermined condition (closed loop, etc.) is met, the purge VSV is
opened by the ECM and stored fuel vapors in the canister are purged to the intake manifold. The ECM
changes the duty cycle ratio of the purge VSV to control purge flow volume.
The purge flow volume is also determined by the intake manifold pressure. Atmospheric pressure is
allowed into the canister through the vent valve to ensure that the purge flow is maintained when the
negative pressure (vacuum) is applied to the canister.
Key-off monitor
This monitor checks for Evaporative Emission (EVAP) system leaks and canister pump module
malfunctions. The monitor starts 5 hours* after the power switch is turned OFF. More than 5 hours are
required to allow the fuel to cool down to stabilize the Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP), thus making the EVAP
system monitor more accurate.
The leak detection pump creates negative pressure (vacuum) in the EVAP system and the pressure is
measured. Finally, the ECM monitors for leaks from the EVAP system and malfunctions in both the
canister pump module and purge VSV, based on the EVAP pressure.
HINT:
*: If the engine coolant temperature is not below 35°C (95°F) 5 hours after the power switch is turned OFF,
the monitor check starts 2 hours later. If it is still not below 35°C (95°F) 7 hours after the power switch is
turned OFF, the monitor check starts 2.5 hours later.
ES
ES–254
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Location
EVAP Hose (From Canister)
Purge Line
ES
EVAP Hose (To Intake Manifold)
Purge VSV
Pump Module
Trap Canister
- Leak Detection Pump
- Canister Pressure Sensor
- Vent Valve
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor
Pressure Switching Valve
Canister Filter
Canister
Fuel Tank
Air Inlet Port
Fuel Cap
A131350E01
ES–255
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Diagram
Intake Manifold
Purge VSV
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor
Fuel Cap
Pressure Switching Valve
Fresh Air Line
ES
Canister
Fuel Pump Chamber
Canister Filter
Bladder Tank
Trap Canister with Pump Module
Outer Tank
Roll Over Valve
A130305E01
Pump Module
: Air Flow
Vent Valve (ON)
From
Canister
Filter
Trap Canister
Vent Valve (OFF)
Reference Orifice
Pressure Sensor
Leak Detection Pump (OFF)
Leak Detection Pump (ON)
A131438E01
ES–256
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Canister Pressure Sensor Specification
Malfunction Area
Output Voltage
4.900 V
4.150 V
Usable Range
ES
1.425 V
Malfunction Area
0.450 V
60 kPa
110 kPa
(450 mmHg) (825 mmHg)
Pressure
HINT:
Standard atmospheric pressure is 101.3 kPa (760mmHg)
A115543E09
Components
Operations
Canister, Trap canister
Contains activated charcoal to absorb EVAP generated in fuel tank.
Cut-off valve
Located in fuel tank. Valve floats and closes when fuel tank 100% full.
Purge Vacuum Switching Valve (VSV)
Opens or closes line between canister and intake manifold. ECM uses
purge VSV to control EVAP purge flow. In order to discharge EVAP
absorbed by canister to intake manifold, ECM opens purge VSV.
EVAP discharge volume to intake manifold controlled by purge VSV
duty cycle ratio (current-carrying time) (open: ON; closed: OFF).
Roll-over valve
Located in fuel tank. Valve closes by its own weight when vehicle
overturns to prevent fuel from spilling out.
Soak timer
Built into ECM. To ensure accurate EVAP monitor, measures 5 hours
(+-15 min) after power switch OFF. This allows fuel to cool down,
stabilizing Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP). When approximately 5 hours
elapsed, ECM activates.
Pressure switching valve
The pressure switching valve located on the canister is used to detect
leakage from the bladder tank into the fuel tank. The valve opens
during the bladder tank leak check. Then, the fuel tank's fuel vapor
flows to the intake manifold without passing the canister.
Pump module
Consists of (a) to (d) below. pump module cannot be disassembled.
(a) Vent valve
Vents and closes EVAP system. When ECM turns valve ON, EVAP
system closed. When ECM turns valve OFF, EVAP system vented.
Negative pressure (vacuum) created in EVAP system to check for
EVAP leaks by closing purge VSV, turning vent valve ON (closed) and
operating leak detection pump.
(b) Canister pressure sensor
Indicates pressure as voltage. ECM supplies regulated 5 V to canister
pressure sensor, and uses feedback from sensor to monitor EVAP
system pressure.
(c) Leak detection pump
Creates negative pressure (vacuum) in EVAP system for leak check.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Components
ES–257
Operations
Has opening with 0.02 inch diameter. Vacuum produced through
orifice by closing purge VSV, turning vent valve OFF and operating
leak detection pump to monitor 0.02 inch leak criterion. 0.02 inch leak
criterion indicates small leak of EVAP.
(d) Reference orifice
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
Canister Pressure Sensor Specification
ES
Malfunction Area
Output Voltage
4,900 V
4,150 V
Usable Range
1,425 V
Malfunction Area
0.450 V
60 kPa
110 kPa
Pressure
HINT:
Standard atmospheric pressure is 101.3 kPa
A115543E03
(a)DTC P0450: Canister pressure sensor voltage abnormal fluctuation
If the canister pressure sensor voltage output rapidly fluctuates between less than 0.45 V and more
than 4.9 V, the ECM interprets this as an open or short circuit malfunction in the canister pressure
sensor or its circuit, and stops the EVAP system monitor. The ECM then illuminates the MIL and sets
the DTC (1 trip detection logic).
(b)DTC P0451: Canister pressure sensor noisy or stuck
If the canister pressure sensor voltage output fluctuates rapidly for 10 seconds, the ECM stops the
EVAP system monitor. The ECM interprets this as noise from the canister pressure sensor, and stops
the EVAP system monitor. The ECM then illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC.
Alternatively, if the sensor voltage output does not change for 10 seconds, the ECM interprets this as
the sensor being stuck, and stops the monitor. The ECM then illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC.
(Both of the malfunctions are detected by 2 trip detection logic).
(c) DTC P0452: Canister pressure sensor voltage low
If the canister pressure sensor voltage output is below 0.45 V, the ECM interprets this as an open or
short circuit malfunction in the canister pressure sensor or its circuit, and stops the EVAP system
monitor. The ECM then illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC (1 trip detection logic).
(d)DTC P0453: Canister pressure sensor voltage high
If the canister pressure sensor voltage output is 4.9 V or more, the ECM interprets this as an open or
short circuit malfunction in the canister pressure sensor or its circuit, and stops the EVAP system
monitor. The ECM then illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC (1 trip detection logic).
ES–258
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
MONITOR STRATEGY
Required Sensors/Components
Canister pump module
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
Within 15 minutes
MIL Operation
Immediate: P0450, P0452, P0453
2 driving cycles: P0451
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
P0451 (Noise Monitor):
ES
Monitor runs whenever following DTCs are not present
None
Atmospheric pressure
70 to 110 kPa (525 to 825 mmHg)
[absolute pressure]
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
Intake air temperature
4.4 to 35 °C (40 to 95°F)
EVAP canister pressure sensor malfunction (P0450, P0452, P0453)
Not detected
Either of following conditions is met
A or B
A. Engine
Running
B. Soak time (power switch OFF time)
5 hours
Example of restart time
First time
7 hours
Second time
9 hours and 30 minutes
P0451 (Stuck Monitor):
Monitor runs whenever following DTCs are not present
None
Atmospheric pressure
70 to 110 kPa (525 to 825 mmHg)
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
Intake air temperature
4.4 to 35°C (40 to 95°F)
EVAP pressure sensor malfunction
Not detected
Soak time (power switch OFF time)
5 hours
Example of restart time
First time
7 hours
Second time
9 hours and 30 minutes
P0450, P0452 and P0453:
Monitor runs whenever following DTCs are not present
None
When either of following condition is met
(a) or (b)
(a) Power switch
ON
(b) Soak timer
ON
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
1. P0450: Canister pressure sensor chattering
EVAP pressure
Less than 42.1 kPa (315.9 mmHg) or more than 123.8 kPa (928.4
mmHg)
2. P0451: Canister pressure sensor noise
Pressure variation indicated by canister pressure sensor in 10
seconds
More than +-0.3 kPa (+-2.25 mmHg) 10 times
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–259
3. P0451: Canister pressure sensor stuck
EVAP pressure change during reference pressure in 10 seconds
Less than 1 kPa (7.5 mmHg)
4. P0452: Canister pressure sensor low voltage
EVAP pressure
Less than 42.1 kPa (315.9 mmHg)
5. P0453: Canister pressure sensor high voltage
EVAP pressure
More than 123.8 kPa (928.4 mmHg)
ES
ES–260
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Canister Pump Module
ECM
Leak Detection Pump
MGND
MTRB
MPMP
ES
5V
VCC
Canister
Pressure
Sensor
VC
VOUT
PPMP
E2
SGND
Vent Valve
VLVB
VPMP
VGND
Purge VSV
EVP1
MAIN
P/I
EFI
EFI M
MREL
A127933E01
ES–261
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
• When a vehicle is brought into the workshop, leave it as it is. Do not change the vehicle
condition. For example, do not tighten the fuel cap.
• Do not disassemble the canister pump module.
• The intelligent tester is required to conduct the following diagnostic troubleshooting
procedure.
1
CONFIRM DTC AND EVAP PRESSURE
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and turn the intelligent
tester ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(d) Read the values.
(e) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / EVAP / VAPOR PRESS.
(f) Read the EVAP pressure displayed on the intelligent
tester.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Test Result
P0451
-
P0452
Suspected Trouble Areas
•
Canister pressure sensor
A
•
Wire harness/connector
(ECM - canister pressure
sensor)
Canister pressure sensor
Short in ECM circuit
B
Wire harness/connector
(ECM - canister pressure
sensor)
Canister pressure sensor
Open in ECM circuit
C
Less than 45 kPa (430 mmHg)
•
•
•
P0453
Proceed to
More than 120 kPa (900 mmHg)
•
•
A
Go to step 5
C
Go to step 4
B
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (CANISTER PUMP MODULE - ECM)
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the PPMP (E7-30)
terminal of the ECM connector and the body ground.
E7
PPMP
ECM Connector
A065744E68
ES
ES–262
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Result
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
•
10 Ω or less
•
•
10 kΩ or more
•
Proceed to
Wire harness/connector (ECM canister pressure sensor)
Short in canister pressure sensor
circuit
A
Wire harness/connector (ECM canister pressure sensor)
Short in ECM circuit
B
B
Go to step 7
A
ES
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (CANISTER PUMP MODULE - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the V7 canister connector.
(b) Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
A130306
(c) Measure the resistance between the PPMP (E7-30)
terminal of the ECM connector and the body ground.
E7
PPMP
ECM Connector
A065744E68
Result
Test Results
10 kΩ or more
10 kΩ or less
Suspected Trouble Areas
Short in canister pressure sensor
circuit
A
•
Short in wire harness/connector (ECM
- canister pressure sensor)
B
B
A
Proceed to
•
Go to step 6
ES–263
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (CANISTER PUMP MODULE - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the V7 canister connector.
ES
A130306
Wire Harness Side
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Measure the voltage and resistance of the canister pump
module connector.
Standard voltage
VOUT
SGND
VCC
V7
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V7-4 (VCC) - Body ground
4.5 to 5.0 V
V7-3 (VOUT) - Body ground
4.5 to 5.0 V
Canister Pump Module Connector
Standard resistance
A085258E38
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V7-2 (SGND) - Body ground
100 Ω or less
Result
Test Results
Suspected Trouble Areas
Proceed to
Voltage and resistance within standard
ranges
•
Open in canister pressure sensor
circuit
A
Voltage and resistance outside standard
ranges
•
Open in wire harness/connector (ECM
- canister pressure sensor)
B
B
Go to step 6
A
5
REPLACE CANISTER ASSEMBLY
(a) Replace the canister assembly (see page EC-9).
NOTICE:
When replacing the canister, check the canister
pump module interior and related pipes for water,
fuel or other liquids. If liquids are present, check for
disconnections and/or cracks in the following: 1) the
pipe from the air inlet port to the canister pump
module; 2) the canister filter; and 3) the fuel tank
vent hose.
ES–264
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES
Vent Hose
Inspection Area*
Canister Filter
Vent Hose
Air Inlet Port
*: Check for disconnection and/or crack
A130304E01
NEXT
6
Go to step 8
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR
HINT:
If the exhaust tailpipe has been removed, go to the next step
before reinstalling it.
NEXT
7
Go to step 8
REPLACE ECM
(a) Replace the ECM (see page ES-469).
NEXT
8
Go to step 8
CHECK WHETHER DTC OUTPUT RECURS (AFTER REPAIR)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–265
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and turn the intelligent
tester ON.
(c) Wait for at least 60 seconds.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / PENDING CODES.
HINT:
If no pending DTC is displayed on the intelligent tester,
the repair has been successfully completed.
NEXT
COMPLETED
ES
ES–266
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0455
Evaporative Emission Control System Leak
Detected (Gross Leak)
DTC
P0456
Evaporative Emission Control System Leak
Detected (Very Small Leak)
DTC SUMMARY
DTC No.
Monitoring Items
ES
P0455
P0456
EVAP gross leak
EVAP small leak
Malfunction
Detection
Conditions
Leak detection pump
creates negative
pressure (vacuum) in
EVAP system and
EVAP system
pressure measured.
0.02 inch leak
criterion measured at
start and at end of
leak check.
If stabilized pressure
higher than [second
0.02 inch leak
criterion x 0.15], ECM
determines that
EVAP system has
large leakage.
Leak detection pump
creates negative
pressure (vacuum) in
EVAP system and
EVAP system
pressure measured.
0.02 inch leak
criterion measured at
start and at end of
leak check.
If stabilized pressure
higher than second
0.02 inch leak
criterion, ECM
determines that
EVAP system has
small leakage.
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
•
•
Fuel cap (loose)
Leakage from
EVAP line
(canister - fuel
tank)
Leakage from
EVAP line (purge
VSV - canister)
Canister pump
module
Leakage from
fuel tank
Leakage from
canister
Same as above
Detection Timing
Detection Logic
While power switch
OFF
2 trip
While power switch
OFF
2 trip
DESCRIPTION
NOTICE:
In this vehicle's EVAP system, turning ON the vent valve does not seal off the EVAP system. To
check for leaks in the EVAP system, disconnect the air inlet vent hose and apply pressure from
the atmosphere side of the canister.
While the engine is running, if a predetermined condition (closed loop, etc.) is met, the purge VSV is
opened by the ECM and stored fuel vapors in the canister are purged to the intake manifold. The ECM
changes the duty cycle ratio of the purge VSV to control purge flow volume.
The purge flow volume is also determined by the intake manifold pressure. Atmospheric pressure is
allowed into the canister through the vent valve to ensure that the purge flow is maintained when the
negative pressure (vacuum) is applied to the canister.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–267
Key-off monitor
This monitor checks for Evaporative Emission (EVAP) system leaks and canister pump module
malfunctions. The monitor starts 5 hours* after the power switch is turned OFF. More than 5 hours are
required to allow the fuel to cool down to stabilize the Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP), thus making the EVAP
system monitor more accurate.
The leak detection pump creates negative pressure (vacuum) in the EVAP system and the pressure is
measured. Finally, the ECM monitors for leaks from the EVAP system and malfunctions in both the
canister pump module and purge VSV, based on the EVAP pressure.
HINT:
*: If the engine coolant temperature is not below 35°C (95°F) 5 hours after the power switch is turned OFF,
the monitor check starts 2 hours later. If it is still not below 35°C (95°F) 7 hours after the power switch is
turned OFF, the monitor check starts 2.5 hours later.
ES
ES–268
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Location
EVAP Hose (From Canister)
Purge Line
ES
EVAP Hose (To Intake Manifold)
Purge VSV
Pump Module
Trap Canister
- Leak Detection Pump
- Canister Pressure Sensor
- Vent Valve
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor
Pressure Switching Valve
Canister Filter
Canister
Fuel Tank
Air Inlet Port
Fuel Cap
A131350E01
ES–269
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Diagram
Intake Manifold
Purge VSV
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor
Fuel Cap
Pressure Switching Valve
Fresh Air Line
ES
Canister
Fuel Pump Chamber
Canister Filter
Bladder Tank
Trap Canister with Pump Module
Outer Tank
Roll Over Valve
A130305E01
Pump Module
: Air Flow
Vent Valve (ON)
From
Canister
Filter
Trap Canister
Vent Valve (OFF)
Reference Orifice
Pressure Sensor
Leak Detection Pump (OFF)
Leak Detection Pump (ON)
A131438E01
ES–270
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Canister Pressure Sensor Specification
Malfunction Area
Output Voltage
4.900 V
4.150 V
Usable Range
ES
1.425 V
Malfunction Area
0.450 V
60 kPa
110 kPa
(450 mmHg) (825 mmHg)
Pressure
HINT:
Standard atmospheric pressure is 101.3 kPa (760mmHg)
A115543E09
Components
Operations
Canister, Trap canister
Contains activated charcoal to absorb EVAP generated in fuel tank.
Cut-off valve
Located in fuel tank. Valve floats and closes when fuel tank 100% full.
Purge Vacuum Switching Valve (VSV)
Opens or closes line between canister and intake manifold. ECM uses
purge VSV to control EVAP purge flow. In order to discharge EVAP
absorbed by canister to intake manifold, ECM opens purge VSV.
EVAP discharge volume to intake manifold controlled by purge VSV
duty cycle ratio (current-carrying time) (open: ON; closed: OFF).
Roll-over valve
Located in fuel tank. Valve closes by its own weight when vehicle
overturns to prevent fuel from spilling out.
Soak timer
Built into ECM. To ensure accurate EVAP monitor, measures 5 hours
(+-15 min) after power switch OFF. This allows fuel to cool down,
stabilizing Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP). When approximately 5 hours
elapsed, ECM activates.
Pressure switching valve
The pressure switching valve located on the canister is used to detect
leakage from the bladder tank into the fuel tank. The valve opens
during the bladder tank leak check. Then, the fuel tank's fuel vapor
flows to the intake manifold without passing the canister.
Pump module
Consists of (a) to (d) below. Pump module cannot be disassembled.
(a) Vent valve
Vents and closes EVAP system. When ECM turns valve ON, EVAP
system closed. When ECM turns valve OFF, EVAP system vented.
Negative pressure (vacuum) created in EVAP system to check for
EVAP leaks by closing purge VSV, turning vent valve ON (closed) and
operating leak detection pump (refer to fig. 1).
(b) Canister pressure sensor
Indicates pressure as voltage. ECM supplies regulated 5 V to canister
pressure sensor, and uses feedback from sensor to monitor EVAP
system pressure (refer to fig. 2).
(c) Leak detection pump
Creates negative pressure (vacuum) in EVAP system for leak check.
ES–271
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Components
Operations
Has opening with 0.02 inch diameter. Vacuum produced through
orifice by closing purge VSV, turning vent valve OFF and operating
leak detection pump to monitor 0.02 inch leak criterion. 0.02 inch leak
criterion indicates small leak of EVAP.
(d) Reference orifice
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
5 hours* after the power switch is turned OFF, the leak detection pump creates negative pressure
(vacuum) in the EVAP system. The ECM monitors for leaks and actuator malfunctions based on the EVAP
pressure.
HINT:
*: If the engine coolant temperature is not below 35°C (95°F) 5 hours after the power switch is turned OFF,
the monitor check starts 2 hours later. If it is still not below 35°C (95°F) 7 hours after the power switch is
turned OFF, the monitor check starts 2.5 hours later.
Sequence
Descriptions
Duration
ECM activation
Activated by soak timer 5, 7 or 9.5
hours after power switch OFF.
-
Atmospheric pressure
measurement
Vent valve turned OFF (vent) and
EVAP system pressure measured
by ECM in order to register
atmospheric pressure.
If pressure in EVAP system not
between 70 kPa and 110 kPa
(525 mmHg and 825 mmHg),
ECM cancels EVAP system
monitor.
10 seconds
First 0.02 inch leak criterion
measurement
In order to determine 0.02 inch
leak criterion, leak detection
pump creates negative pressure
(vacuum) through reference
orifice and then ECM checks if
leak detection pump and vent
valve operate normally.
60 seconds
EVAP system pressure
measurement
Vent valve turned ON (closed) to
shut EVAP system.
Negative pressure (vacuum)
created in EVAP system, and
EVAP system pressure then
measured.
Write down measured value as it
will be used in leak check.
If EVAP pressure does not
stabilize within 900 seconds,
ECM cancels EVAP system
monitor.
900 seconds*
Purge VSV monitor
Purge VSV opened and then
EVAP system pressure measured
by ECM.
Large increase indicates normal.
10 seconds
E
Second 0.02 inch leak criterion
measurement
After second 0.02 inch leak
criterion measurement, leak
check performed by comparing
first and second 0.02 inch leak
criterion.
If stabilized system pressure
higher than second 0.02 inch leak
criterion, ECM determines that
EVAP system leaking.
60 seconds
-
Final check
Atmospheric pressure measured
and then monitoring result
recorded by ECM.
-
-
A
B
C
D
Operations
*: If only a small amount of fuel is in the fuel tank, it takes longer for the EVAP pressure to stabilize.
ES
ES–272
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Operation A: Atmospheric Pressure Measurement
Purge VSV: OFF
Canister
Fuel Tank
Vent Valve: OFF (vent)
Reference
Orifice
ES
Canister
Pressure
Sensor
Operation B, E: 0.02 Inch Leak
Criterion Measurement
OFF
OFF (vent)
Canister Pump Module
Canister Filter
ON
Leak Detection Pump: OFF
Operation C: EVAP System Pressure Measurement
OFF
ON
ON (closed)
Atmospheric
Pressure
Negative
Pressure
Operation D: Purge VSV Monitor
ON
ON (closed)
ON
A122912E01
1. P0455: EVAP gross leak
In operation C, the leak detection pump creates negative pressure (vacuum) in the EVAP system and
the EVAP system pressure is measured. If the stabilized system pressure is higher than [second 0.02
inch leak criterion x 0.15] (near atmospheric pressure), the ECM determines that the EVAP system has
a large leakage, illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC (2 trip detection logic).
ES–273
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
2. P0456: EVAP very small leak
In operation C, the leak detection pump creates negative pressure (vacuum) in the EVAP system and
the EVAP system pressure is measured. If the stabilized system pressure is higher than the second
0.02 inch leak criterion, the ECM determines that the EVAP system has a small leakage, illuminates
the MIL and sets the DTC (2 trip detection logic).
EVAP Pressure when EVAP System Leaks:
ON
Purge VSV
ON: Open
OFF: Closed
Vent Valve
ON
Leak Detection
Pump
ON
EVAP Pressure
ON: Closed
OFF: Vent
P0455
Positive
Negative
P0456
0.02 Inch
Leak Criterion
OK
A
B
C
D
E
10
60
Within 900
10
60
Sequence
Time (Second)
A106061E03
MONITOR STRATEGY
Required Sensors/Components
Purge VSV and canister pump module
Frequency of Operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
Maximum 15 seconds
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
P0011, P0012, P0021, P0022 (VVT system-Advance, Retard)
P0100, P0101, P0102, P0103 (MAF sensor)
P0110, P0112, P0113 (IAT sensor)
P0115, P0116, P0117, P0118 (ECT sensor)
P0120, P0122, P0123, P0220, P0222, P0223, P2135,(TP sensor)
P0125 (Insufficient ECT for closed loop)
P0171, P0172, P0174, P0175 (Fuel system)
P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303, P0304 (Misfire)
P0335 (CKP sensor)
P0340, P0341 (CMP sensor)
P0351, P0352, P0353, P0354 (Igniter)
P0450, P0452, P0453 (EVAP press sensor)
P0500 (VSS)
Atmospheric pressure
70 to 110 kPa (525 to 825 mmHg)
ES
ES–274
ES
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Battery voltage
10.5 V or higher
Vehicle speed
Less than 4 km/h (2.5 mph)
Power switch
OFF
Time after key off
5 or 7 or 9.5 hours
Purge VSV
Not operated by scan tool
Vent valve
Not operated by scan tool
Leak detection pump
Not operated by scan tool
Both of the following conditions 1 and 2 are met before key off
-
1. Duration that vehicle has been driven
5 minutes or more
2. EVAP purge operation
Performed
ECT
4.4 to 35°C (40 to 95°F)
IAT
4.4 to 35°C (40 to 95°F)
1. Key-off monitor sequence 1 to 8
1. Atmospheric pressure measurement
Next sequence is run if the following condition is met
-
Atmospheric pressure change
Within 0.3 kPa (2.25 mmHg) in 1 second
2. First reference pressure measurement
Next sequence is run if the following conditions are met
-
EVAP pressure just after reference pressure measurement start
-1 kPa (-7.5 mmHg) or lower
Reference pressure
-4.85 to -1.05 kPa (726 to 754 mmHg)
Reference pressure
Saturated within 60 seconds
3. Vent valve stuck closed check
Next sequence is run if the following condition is met
-
EVAP pressure change after vent valve is ON
0.3 kPa (2.25 mmHg) or more
4. Vacuum introduction
Next sequence is run if the following condition is met
-
EVAP pressure
Saturated within 900 seconds
5. Purge VSV stuck closed check
Next sequence is run if the following condition is met
-
EVAP pressure change after purge valve is open
0.3 kPa (2.25 mmHg) or more
6. Second reference pressure measurement
Next sequence is run if the following conditions are met
-
EVAP pressure just after reference pressure measurement
-1 kPa (-7.5 mmHg) or lower
Reference pressure
-4.85 to -1.05 kPa (726 to 754 mmHg)
Reference pressure
Saturated within 60 seconds
Reference pressure difference between first and second
Less than 0.7 kPa (5.25 mmHg)
7. Leak check
Next sequence is run if the following condition is met
-
EVAP pressure when vacuum introduction is complete
Lower than second reference pressure
8. Atmospheric pressure measurement
EVAP monitor is complete if the following condition is met
-
Atmospheric pressure difference between sequence 1 and 8
Within 0.3 kPa (2.25 mmHg)
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
"Saturated" indicates that the EVAP pressure change is less than 0.1 kPa (0.75 mmHg) in 30 seconds.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–275
P0455: EVAP gross leak
FTP when vacuum introduction complete
Higher than reference pressure x 0.15
P0456: EVAP small leak
FTP when vacuum introduction complete
Between "reference pressure" and "reference pressure x 0.15"
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to CHECKING MONITOR STATUS (see page ES-15).
ES
ES–276
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Canister Pump Module
ECM
Leak Detection Pump
MGND
MTRB
MPMP
ES
5V
VCC
Canister
Pressure
Sensor
VC
VOUT
PPMP
E2
SGND
Vent Valve
VLVB
VPMP
VGND
Purge VSV
EVP1
MAIN
P/I
EFI
EFI M
MREL
A127933E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
The intelligent tester is required to conduct the following diagnostic troubleshooting procedure.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–277
HINT:
• Using the intelligent tester monitor results enable the EVAP system to be confirmed.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine conditions
when malfunctions are detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the
vehicle was moving or stationary, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or
rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
CONFIRM DTC
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
Turn the power switch OFF and wait for 10 seconds.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the power switch OFF and wait for 10 seconds.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(g) Check if DTC P0446 is output.
NO
Go to step 5
YES
2
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK
(a) Note the freeze frame data and DTCs.
(b) Clear DTCs.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK / EVAP SYS CHECK / AUTO
OPERATION.
(d) After the system check is finished, check for pending
DTCs.
OK:
No DTC is present.
NG
Go to step 6
OK
3
CHECK OPERATION FOR PRESSURE SWITCHING VALVE
(a) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / TANK BYPASS VSV.
(b) Touch the pressure switching valve (TANK BYPASS
VSV) to feel the operating vibration.
OK:
The pressure switching valve is operated by the
ACTIVE TEST.
NG
OK
Go to step 18
ES
ES–278
4
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK PRESSURE SWITCHING VALVE
Air
E
F
VSV is ON
ES
Turn the power switch OFF.
Remove the pressure switching valve (see page EC-31).
Reconnect the pressure switching valve connector.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / TANK BYPASS VSV.
(e) Check the airflow for the pressure switching valve.
OK:
The pressure switching valve operates normally.
Air
E
F
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
VSV is OFF
A087973E01
5
NG
Go to step 19
OK
Go to step 33
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK
(a) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK / EVAP SYS CHECK / AUTO
OPERATION.
(b) After the system check is finished, check for pending
DTCs.
OK:
DTCs are present.
NG
CHECK INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
OK
6
CHECK DTC
(a) Check the DTCs that were present at the EVAP system
check.
OK:
P043E, P043F, P2401, P2402 and P2419 are present.
NG
Go to step 10
OK
7
CHECK VENT VALVE CLOSE STUCK
(a) Allow the engine to idle.
(b) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / EVAP VSV.
(c) Turn the EVAP VSV ON (purge VSV open) and check
the VAPOR PRESS (EVAP pressure) for 10 seconds.
OK:
EVAP pressure is higher than 755 mmHg.
NG
Go to step 20
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–279
OK
8
CHECK LEAK DETECTION PUMP OPERATION
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / VACUUM PUMP.
(d) Touch the pump module to feel the operating vibration.
OK:
The leak detection pump is operated by the
ACTIVE TEST.
NG
Go to step 21
OK
9
CHECK TRAP CANISTER
(a) Disconnect the vent hose from the pump module.
(b) Check that no moisture is in the pump module or the
vent hose.
OK:
No moisture.
OK
Go to step 22
NG
Go to step 23
A135512
10
CHECK DTC
(a) Check the DTCs that were present at the EVAP system
check.
OK:
P0441, P0455 and/or P0456 are present.
NG
Go to step 16
OK
11
CHECK INSTALLATION FOR FUEL CAP
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Remove the fuel cap.
Reinstall the fuel cap.
Clear DTCs.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK / EVAP SYS CHECK / AUTO
OPERATION.
(e) After the system check is finished, check for pending
DTCs.
ES
ES–280
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
HINT:
If no DTC is present, this indicates that the fuel cap is
loosened.
OK:
No DTC is present.
OK
REPAIR COMPLETED
NG
12
LOCATE LEAK POINT
(a) Disconnect the vent hose (fresh air line) as shown in the
illustration.
ES
Canister Filter
Vent Hose to Canister
Vent Hose
Adapter
EVAP Tester
A131407E01
(b) Connect the pressure gauge and air pump as shown in
the illustration.
(c) Pressurize the EVAP system until 24 to 28 mmHg.
(d) Locate the leak point.
HINT:
If the EVAP system has leakage, a whistling sound may
be heard.
OK:
The leak point is found.
OK
Go to step 24
NG
13
CHECK FUEL CAP
Check that the fuel cap meets OEM specifications.
HINT:
If an EVAP tester is available, perform the fuel cap test
according to the tester's instructions.
OK:
Fuel cap meets OEM specifications.
NG
Go to step 25
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–281
OK
14
CHECK OPERATION FOR PURGE VSV
(a) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / EVAP VSV.
(b) Touch the purge VSV to feel the operating vibration.
OK:
The purge VSV (EVAP VSV) is operated by the
ACTIVE TEST.
NG
Go to step 26
OK
15
CHECK INTAKE MANIFOLD PRESSURE
(a) Disconnect the purge VSV hose that is connected to the
throttle body.
(b) Allow the engine to idle.
(c) Check that the hose has suction using your finger.
OK:
The hose has suction.
Purge VSV
Hose (to Intake Manifold)
A130450E01
16
NG
Go to step 27
OK
Go to step 28
CHECK DTC
(a) Check the DTCs that were present at the EVAP system
check.
OK:
P0451 is not present.
NG
Go to step 9
OK
17
CHECK OPERATION FOR VENT VALVE
(a) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / VENT VALVE.
(b) Touch the pump module to feel the operating vibration.
OK:
The vent valve is operated by the ACTIVE TEST.
OK
Go to step 9
NG
Go to step 29
ES
ES–282
18
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (PRESSURE SWITCHING VALVE - ECM AND EFI M
RELAY)
Wire Harness Side
Pressure Switching Valve Connector
(a) Check the harness and the connectors between the
pressure switching valve and the ECM.
(1) Disconnect the V8 pressure switching valve
connector.
V8
ES
Front View
A072890E04
(2) Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
(3) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E7
TBP
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V8-1 (Pressure switching valve) - E718 (TBP)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
ECM Connector
A065744E70
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V8-1 (Pressure switching valve) or
E7-18 (TBP) - Body ground
10 kΩ higher
(4) Reconnect the pressure switching valve connector.
(5) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(b) Check the harness and the connectors between the
pressure switching valve and the EFI M relay.
(1) Disconnect the V8 pressure switching valve
connector.
(2) Remove the integration relay from the engine room
relay block.
(3) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connector.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
8 3I
Engine Room Relay Block
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V8-2 (Pressure switching valve) - 3I-8
(EFI M relay)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
A082810E01
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V8-2 (Pressure switching valve) or 3I8 (EFI M relay) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(4) Reconnect the pressure switching valve connector.
(5) Reinstall the integration relay.
NG
Go to step 30
OK
Go to step 31
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
19
ES–283
REPLACE PRESSURE SWITCHING VALVE
Replace the pressure switching valve (see page EC-31).
NEXT
20
Go to step 34
CHECK FOR VENT HOSE CLOG
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the vent hose (fresh air line) as shown in the
illustration.
(c) Allow the engine to idle.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / EVAP VSV.
(e) Turn the purge VSV (EVAP VSV) ON and check the
EVAP pressure (VAPOR PRESS) for 10 seconds.
OK:
EVAP pressure is higher than 755 mmHg.
A135512
21
NG
Go to step 22
OK
Go to step 32
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (LEAK DETECTION PUMP - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the V7 canister connector
Wire Harness Side
V7
MTRB
Canister
Connector
MGND
Front View
A085258E49
(b) Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E7
MPMP
ECM Connector
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V7-1 (MTRB) - E7-13 (MPMP)
Below 1 Ω
V7-6 (MGND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
A065744E71
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V7-1 (MTRB) or E7-13 (MPMP) - Body
ground
10 kΩ higher
(d) Reconnect the canister connector.
(e) Reconnect the ECM connector.
ES
ES–284
22
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
NG
Go to step 30
OK
Go to step 31
REPLACE TRAP CANISTER WITH PUMP MODULE
Replace the trap canister with pump module (see page EC17).
NEXT
ES
23
Go to step 34
CHECK FOR VENT HOSE DAMAGE
Check for hose damage as shown in the illustration. If
necessary, replace the vent hose.
Vent Hose
Inspection Area*
Canister Filter
Vent Hose
Air Inlet Port
*: Check for disconnection and/or crack
A130304E01
NEXT
Go to step 22
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
24
25
26
ES–285
REPAIR OR REPLACE LEAK POINT
NEXT
Go to step 34
NEXT
Go to step 34
REPLACE FUEL CAP
ES
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (PURGE VSV - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the V1 purge VSV connector.
Wire Harness Side
Purge VSV
Connector
V1
Front View
A052933E24
(b) Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
(c) Check the harness and the connectors between the
ECM and the purge VSV connectors.
(1) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connector.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E5
ECM Connector
EVP1
A065745E73
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V1-1 - E5-14 (EVP1)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V1-1 or E5-14 (EVP1) - Body ground
10 kΩ higher
(d) Remove the integration relay from the engine room relay
block.
(e) Check the harness and connectors between the purge
VSV connector and the EFI M relay.
(1) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
8 3I
Engine Room Relay Block
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V1-2 - 3I-8 (EFI M relay)
Below 1 Ω
A082810E01
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V1-2 or 3I-8 (EFI M relay) - Body
ground
10 kΩ higher
(f) Reconnect the purge VSV connector.
(g) Reconnect the ECM connector.
ES–286
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(h) Reinstall the integration relay.
27
NG
Go to step 30
OK
Go to step 31
REPLACE HOSE (PURGE VSV - THROTTLE BODY)
NEXT
ES
28
Go to step 34
REPLACE PURGE VSV
Replace the purge VSV (see page EC-23).
NEXT
29
Go to step 34
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (VENT VALVE - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the V7 canister connector.
Wire Harness Side
VLVB
V7
Canister
Connector
Front View
VGND
A085258E50
(b) Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
(c) Check the harness and the connectors between the
ECM and the canister connectors.
(1) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connector.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E7
VPMP
ECM Connector
A065744E72
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V7-8 (VGND) - E7-26 (VPMP)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V7-8 (VGND) or E7-26 (VPMP) - Body
ground
10 kΩ higher
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–287
(d) Remove the integration relay from the engine room relay
block.
(e) Check the harness and connectors between the canister
connector and the EFI M relay.
(1) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
8 3I
Engine Room Relay Block
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V7-9 (VLVB) - 3I-8 (EFI M relay)
Below 1 Ω
A082810E01
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V7-9 (VLVB) or 3I-8 (EFI M relay) Body ground
10 kΩ higher
(f) Reconnect the canister connector.
(g) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(h) Reinstall the integration relay.
30
NG
Go to step 30
OK
Go to step 31
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
NEXT
31
Go to step 34
REPLACE ECM
Replace the ECM (see page ES-469).
NEXT
32
CHECK AND REPLACE VENT HOSE OR CANISTER FILTER
NEXT
33
Go to step 34
Go to step 34
REPLACE HOSE (PRESSURE SWITCHING VALVE AND FUEL TANK)
NEXT
34
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK / EVAP SYS CHECK / AUTO
OPERATION.
(c) After the system check is finished, check for pending
DTCs.
ES
ES–288
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
OK:
No DTC is present.
NG
Go to step 6
OK
35
PERFORM EVAP MONITOR DRIVE PATTERN
(a) Check that the following conditions are met:
• Fuel level is 1/8 to 7/8.
• Engine coolant temperature (ECT) is 4.4 to 35°C (40
to 95°F).
• Intake air temperature (IAT) is 4.4 to 35°C (40 to
95°F).
• Difference of ECT and IAT is less than 7°C (13°F).
(b) Enter the check mode. Enter the following menus:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / CHECK MODE.
(c) Allow the engine to idle until the ECT is 75°C (167°F).
(d) Drive the vehicle at 50 km/h (30 mph) or faster and
maintain that speed for 60 seconds or more.
(e) Stop the vehicle. Do not turn the power switch OFF.
(f) Check that the EVAP monitor status is complete. Enter
the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II /
MONITOR STATUS.
(g) If the EVAP monitor is incomplete, drive the vehicle at 50
km/h (30 mph) or faster and maintain that speed for 120
seconds or more. After that, recheck the EVAP monitor
status.
(h) Check for pending DTCs.
OK:
No DTC is present.
ES
NG
OK
REPAIR COMPLETED
Go to step 2
ES–289
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0505
Idle Control System Malfunction
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The idle speed is controlled by the Electronic Throttle Control System (ETCS).
The ETCS is composed of the throttle motor which operates the throttle valve, and the throttle position
sensor which detects the opening angle of the throttle valve.
The ECM controls the throttle motor to provide the proper throttle valve opening angle to obtain the target
idle speed.
The ECM regulates the idle speed by opening and closing the throttle valve using the ETCS. If the actual
idle RPM varies more than a specified amount or a learned value of the idle speed control remains at the
maximum or minimum five times or more during a trip, the ECM concludes that there is a problem in the
idle speed control ECM function. The ECM will turn on the MIL and a DTC is set.
Example:
If the actual idle RPM varies from the target idle RPM by more than 200 (*1) rpm five times during a drive
cycle, the ECM will turn on the MIL and a DTC is set.
HINT:
*1: RPM threshold varies depending on engine loads.
Large
Target RPM
Idle Engine
RPM
Maximum
Learned Value
of Idle Speed
Control
0
Actual Idle RPM
Minimum
Small
Time
Time
A082389E21
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0505
Idle speed continues to vary greatly from
target speed
(1 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
Electric throttle control system
Air induction system
PCV hose connection
ECM
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0505: Idle air control malfunction (Functional check)
ES
ES–290
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Required sensors/components
Main:
Crankshaft position sensor
Related:
Vehicle speed sensor, engine coolant temperature sensor
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
10 minutes
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
None
Engine
Running
ES
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Following conditions are met:
(during idling after driving for more than 6.2 mph (10 km/h) per cycle)
A, B and C
A. Either of following conditions is met:
1 or 2
1. Deviation of engine speed
(when shift position N or A/C ON)
Less than -100 rpm, or more than 200 rpm
2. Deviation of engine speed
(when shift position D or A/C OFF)
Less than -100 rpm, or more than 150 rpm
B. IAC flow rate (learned value)
0.6 L/sec or less or 4.5 L/sec or more
C. Number of detection
5 times/trip
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine condition when
malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was
running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or rich, and other data
from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
CHECK OTHER DTC OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P0505)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC output)
Proceed to
P0505
A
P0505 and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides P0505 are output, perform
troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–291
A
2
CHECK CONNECTION OF PCV HOSE
OK:
PCV hose is connected correctly and has no damage.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE PCV HOSE
OK
3
CHECK AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
ES
(a) Check for vacuum leaks in the air induction system.
OK:
No leakage in the air induction system.
NG
OK
CHECK ELECTRIC THROTTLE CONTROL SYSTEM
REPAIR OR REPLACE AIR INDUCTION
SYSTEM
ES–292
DTC
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
P0560
System Voltage
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The battery supplies electricity to the ECM even if the power switch is OFF. This electricity allows the
ECM to store DTC history, freeze frame data, fuel trim values, and other data. If the battery voltage falls
below a minimum level, the ECM will conclude that there is a fault in the power supply circuit. The next
time the engine starts, the ECM will turn on the MIL and a DTC will be set.
ES
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0560
Open in back-up power source circuit
•
•
Open in back-up power source circuit
ECM
HINT:
If DTC P0560 is present, the ECM will not store other DTCs.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0560: System voltage malfunction
Required sensors/components (main)
ECM
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
3 seconds
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
None
Stand-by RAM
Initialized
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Battery voltage
Less than 3.5 V
ES–293
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
P/I
EFI
BATT
MAIN
E1
ES
Battery
A127919E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine condition when
malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was
running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or rich, and other data
from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
CHECK FUSE (EFI FUSE)
(a) Remove the EFI fuse from the engine room relay block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the EFI fuse.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
(c) Reinstall the EFI fuse.
Engine Room Relay Block
NG
EFI Fuse
A082798E01
OK
CHECK FOR SHORT IN ALL HARNESS AND
COMPONENTS CONNECTED TO FUSE
ES–294
2
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK ECM (BATTERY VOLTAGE)
E5
(a) Measure the voltage between the specified terminals of
the E5 and E7 ECM connectors.
Standard voltage
E7
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E7-6 (BATT) - E5-28 (E1)
9 to 14 V
OK
E1 (-)
BATT (+)
ECM Connector
ES
REPLACE ECM
A065741E39
NG
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (ECM - EFI FUSE, EFI FUSE - BATTERY)
(a) Check the harness and the connectors between the EFI
fuse and the ECM connector.
(1) Remove the integration relay from the engine room
relay block.
(2) Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
(3) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E7
BATT
ECM Connector
A065744E32
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
2 (EFI fuse) - E7-6 (BATT)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
2 (EFI fuse) or E7-6 (BATT) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(4) Reinstall the integration relay.
(5) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(b) Check the harness and the connectors between the EFI
fuse and the battery.
(1) Remove the integration relay from the engine room
relay block.
(2) Disconnect the positive battery terminal.
(3) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Engine Room Relay Block
1
2
EFI Fuse
A093903E01
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Battery positive terminal - 1 (EFI
fuse)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Battery positive terminal or 1 (EFI
fuse) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(4) Reinstall the integration relay.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–295
(5) Reconnect the positive battery terminal.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
CHECK AND REPLACE ENGINE ROOM RELAY BLOCK
ES
ES–296
ES
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P0604
Internal Control Module Random Access Memory (RAM) Error
DTC
P0606
ECM / PCM Processor
DTC
P0607
Control Module Performance
DTC
P0657
Actuator Supply Voltage Circuit / Open
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM continuously monitors its internal memory status, internal circuits, and output signals to the
throttle actuator. This self-check ensures that the ECM is functioning properly. If any malfunction is
detected, the ECM will set the appropriate DTC and illuminate the MIL.
The ECM memory status is diagnosed by internal "mirroring" of the main CPU and the sub CPU to detect
random access memory (RAM) errors. The two CPUs also perform continuous mutual monitoring. The
ECM sets a DTC if: 1) output from the 2 CPUs are different and deviate from the standards, 2) the signals
to the throttle actuator deviate from the standards, 3) malfunction is found in the throttle actuator supply
voltage, and 4) any other ECM malfunction is found.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0604
P0606
P0607
P0657
ECM internal errors
•
ECM
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0604: ECM RAM errors
P0606: ECM CPU malfunction
P0657: ETCS power supply function of ECM malfunction
Required sensors/components
ECM
Frequency of operation
Continuous: P0604, P0606, P0607
Once per driving cycle: P0657
Duration
Within 4 minutes
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
None
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
ECM RAM errors:
Difference between main and sub CPUs output
Larger than the specified range
ECM CPU malfunction:
Difference between throttle position of main CPU and throttle position
of sub CPU
0.3 V or more
Electronic throttle control system power supply function of ECM malfunction:
Electronic throttle control system power supply when power switch is
turned from OFF to ON
7 V or more
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–297
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine condition when
malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was
running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or rich, and other data
from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
CHECK ECM VOLTAGE (IN ADDITION TO DTC P0604 / P0606 / 0P607 / P0657)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the tester ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(d) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC output)
Proceed to
P0604 or P0606 or P0607 or P0657
A
P0604 or P0606 or P0607 or P0657 and other DTCs
B
B
A
REPLACE ECM
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
ES
ES–298
ES
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P1115
Coolant Temperature Sensor Circuit for Coolant Heat Storage System
DTC
P1117
Coolant Temperature Sensor Circuit Low for
Coolant Heat Storage
DTC
P1118
Coolant Temperature Sensor Circuit High for
Coolant Heat Storage
DESCRIPTION
HINT:
Although each DTC title says "Coolant Temperature Sensor", these DTCs are related to the coolant heat
storage tank outlet temperature sensor.
Coolant Heat Storage System (CHS System)
Coolant Flow
Water Pump for
Air Conditioner
Cabin Heater
Water Valve
Cylinder Head
Cylinder Block
Coolant
Heat
Storage
Tank
Radiator
CHS Water
Pump
Coolant flow during preheat mode
Coolant flow during normal engine
operating
ECM
CHS Tank Outlet Temperature Sensor
A082803E01
This system uses an electric pump to supply hot coolant stored in the coolant heat storage tank into the
cylinder head of the engine, in order to optimize engine starting combustion and reduce the amount of
unburned gas that is discharged while the engine is started. Before the engine starts, the ECM operates
the electric water pump to direct the hot coolant in the heat storage tank into the engine, in order to heat
the cylinder head (this process is called "preheat mode"). The duration of the operation of the electric
water pump is variable, depending on the temperature of the cylinder head. During the normal operation
of the engine, the water valve opens the passage between the cylinder head and the heater and closes
the passage between the cylinder head and the tank. During preheat mode in which the cylinder head is
heated, the water valve opens the passage between the tank and the cylinder head, in order to allow the
coolant to flow from the tank to the cylinder head. At this time, in order to warm up the intake port quickly
before the engine is started, the coolant flows in the reverse direction.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–299
The sensor for the system, which is provided at the tank outlet, is constructed similarly to the engine
coolant temperature sensor and is connected to the ECM. The CHS tank outlet temperature sensor has a
built in thermistor, whose resistance varies with the coolant temperature.
HINT:
If the ECM detects the DTC P0115, P0117 or P0118, it operates the fail-safe function in which the engine
coolant temperature is assumed to be 80°C (176°F).
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P1115
Open or short in CHS tank outlet temperature
sensor circuit for 0.5 seconds
•
•
•
P1117
Short in CHS tank outlet temperature sensor
circuit
•
•
•
P1118
Open in CHS tank outlet temperature sensor
circuit
•
•
•
Open or short in CHS tank outlet
temperature sensor circuit
CHS tank outlet temperature sensor
ECM
Short in CHS tank outlet temperature
sensor circuit
CHS tank outlet temperature sensor
ECM
Open in CHS tank outlet temperature
sensor circuit
CHS tank outlet temperature sensor
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM monitors the sensor voltage and uses this value to control the coolant heat storage (CHS)
system properly. If the sensor output voltage deviates from the normal operating range, the ECM
determines that the CHS tank outlet temperature sensor circuit has malfunctioned, and outputs a DTC.
Example:
A sensor output voltage of -40°C (-40°F) or 140°C (284°F) is determined to be malfunction.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P1115: Coolant temperature sensor circuit for coolant heat storage
system
P1117: Coolant temperature sensor circuit low for coolant heat
storage system
P1118: Coolant temperature sensor circuit high for coolant heat
storage system
Required sensors/components
Coolant heat storage tank outlet temperature sensor
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
0.5 seconds
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
None
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P1115:
Sensor resistance (coolant temperature at CHS tank outlet)
Less than 0.14 V or more than 4.91 V
(more than 140°C (284°F) or -40°C (-40°F) or less)
P1117:
Sensor resistance (coolant temperature at CHS tank outlet)
Less than 0.14 V
(more than 140°C (284°F))
P1118:
Sensor resistance (coolant temperature at CHS tank outlet)
More than 4.19 V
(-40°C (-40°F) or less)
ES
ES–300
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
79 Ω (140°C (284°F)) to 156 kΩ (-40°C (-40°F))
Sensor resistance
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
CHS Tank Outlet Temperature Sensor
5V
THW
ES
R
E2
A119255E04
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
Be careful when replacing any part in the system or changing the coolant because the coolant in
the heat storage tank is hot even if the engine is cold.
HINT:
• If different DTCs related to different systems that have terminal E2 as the ground terminal are output
simultaneously, terminal E2 may have an open circuit.
• To check the coolant heat storage (CHS) system, the ECM may cause the water pump of the CHS
system to operate 5 hours after the power switch has been turned OFF.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine condition
when malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the
vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or
rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and turn the intelligent
tester ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II /DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(d) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P1115
A
P1117
B
P1118
B
B
Go to step 3
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–301
A
2
CHECK ECM (THW2 - E2 VOLTAGE)
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Measure voltage between the terminals THW2 and E2 of
the ECM E4 and E7 connector.
Standard voltage
E7
E4
Water Temperature °C (°F)
E2
THW2
ECM Connector
A124045E09
Voltage
20 (68)
0.5 to 3.4 V
60 (140)
0.2 to 1.0 V
OK
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
NG
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (CHS TANK OUTLET TEMPERATURE SENSOR ECM)
(a) Check the harness and the connectors between the
coolant heat storage tank outlet temperature sensor and
the ECM connectors.
(1) Disconnect the C19 engine coolant heat storage
tank outlet temperature sensor connector.
Wire Harness Side
Front View
C19
CHS Tank Outlet Temperature Sensor Connector
A082813E02
E4
(2) Disconnect the E4 and E7 ECM connector.
(3) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E7
E2
THW2
ECM Connector
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
C19-2 (CHS temperature sensor) E7-33 (THW2)
Below 1 Ω
C19-1 (CHS temperature sensor) E4-28 (E2)
Below 1 Ω
A082814E01
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
C19-2 (CHS temperature sensor) or
E7-33 (THW2) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(4) Reconnect the coolant heat storage tank outlet
temperature sensor connector.
(5) Reconnect the ECM connector.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
ES
ES–302
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
OK
4
INSPECT TEMPERATURE SENSOR (CHS TANK OUTLET TEMPERATURE SENSOR)
(a) Remove the coolant heat storage (CHS) tank outlet
temperature sensor.
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals.
Standard resistance
Ohmmeter
Resistance
kΩ
ES
Acceptable
Temperature °C (°F)
A081700E08
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1-2
2 to 3 kΩ at 20°C (68°F)
1-2
0.2 to 0.4 kΩ at 80°C (176°F)
NOTICE:
In case of checking the CHS tank outlet temperature
sensor in the water, be careful not to allow water to
contact the terminals. After checking, dry the sensor.
HINT:
Alternate procedure: Connect an ohmmeter to the
installed CHS tank outlet temperature sensor and read
the resistance. Use an infrared thermometer to measure
the CHS tank outlet temperature in the immediate vicinity
of the sensor. Compare these values to the resistance/
temperature graph. Change the engine temperature
(warm up or allow to cool down) and repeat the test.
(c) Reinstall the coolant heat storage tank outlet
temperature sensor.
NG
OK
REPLACE ECM
REPLACE TEMPERATURE SENSOR
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P1116
ES–303
Coolant Temperature Sensor Circuit Stack for
Coolant Heat Storage
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P1115 (see page ES-291).
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P1116
•
•
•
Temperature change during hot coolant
recovering:
3°C (1.8°F) or less
Difference between CHS tank outlet
temperature and engine coolant
temperature during hot coolant
recovering:
More than 25°C (45°F)
•
Coolant heat storage tank outlet
temperature sensor
Cooling system (clogging)
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The coolant heat storage (CHS) tank outlet temperature sensor is used for monitoring coolant
temperature in the vicinity of the outlet port of the heat storage tank of the CHS system. The resistance of
the sensor increases when the CHS tank outlet temperature is low, and conversely, the resistance
decreases when the temperature is high. The changes in resistance are reflected in the voltage that is
output by the sensor. The ECM monitors the sensor voltage and uses this value to control CHS system
properly.
If the sensor output voltage deviates from the normal operating range, the ECM determines that the CHS
tank outlet temperature sensor circuit has malfunctioned, and sets a DTC.
Examples:
1) No changes occur in the CHS tank outlet temperature sensor signal (over 1°C [1.8°F]) after a
predetermined length of time has elapsed from the start of the coolant recovering.
2) A significant difference (over 25°C [45°F]) exists between the engine coolant temperature signal and
the CHS tank outlet temperature sensor signal after a predetermined length of time has elapsed from the
start of the coolant recovering.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P1116 : Coolant temperature sensor circuit range check (stuck)
Required sensors/components
Main:
Coolant heat storage tank outlet temperature sensor
Related:
Engine coolant temperature sensor
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
45 seconds
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
None
Coolant heat storage system malfunction
Not detected
Coolant heat recovering
ON
Difference between engine coolant temperature and CHS tank outlet
temperature
More than 30°C (54°F)
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Temperature variation of CHS tank outlet during hot coolant recovery
3°C or less
ES
ES–304
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Difference between temperatures of CHS tank outlet and engine
coolant during hot coolant recovery
More than 25°C (45°F)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P1115 (see page ES-293).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
ES
CAUTION:
Be careful when replacing any part in the system or changing the coolant because the coolant in
the heat storage tank is hot even if the engine is cold.
HINT:
• To check the coolant heat storage (CHS) system, the ECM may cause the water pump of the CHS
system to operate 5 hours after the power switch has been turned OFF.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine condition
when malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the
vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or
rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
CHECK OTHER DTC OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P1116)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC output)
Proceed to
P1116
A
P1116 and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides P1116 are output, perform
troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
A
2
CHECK COOLING SYSTEM (CHECK FOR CLOGGING IN THE COOLANT SYSTEM)
OK:
Coolant passage has no blockage.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE COOLING SYSTEM
OK
REPLACE TEMPERATURE SENSOR (CHS TANK OUTLET TEMPERATURE SENSOR)
ES–305
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P1120
Coolant Flow Control Valve Position Sensor
Circuit
DTC
P1122
Coolant Flow Control Valve Position Sensor
Circuit Low
DTC
P1123
Coolant Flow Control Valve Position Sensor
Circuit High
DESCRIPTION
Coolant Heat Storage System (CHS System)
Coolant Flow
ES
Water Pump for
Air Conditioner
Cabin Heater
Water Valve
Cylinder Head
Cylinder Block
Coolant
Heat
Storage
Tank
Radiator
CHS Water
Pump
Coolant flow during preheat mode
Coolant flow during normal engine
operating
ECM
CHS Tank Outlet Temperature Sensor
A082803E01
This system uses an electric pump to supply hot coolant stored in the heat storage tank into the cylinder
head of the engine, in order to optimize engine starting combustion and reduce the amount of unburned
gas that is discharged while the engine is started. Before the engine starts, the ECM operates the electric
water pump to direct the hot coolant in the heat storage tank into the engine, in order to heat the cylinder
head (this process is called "preheat mode"). The duration of the operation of the electric water pump is
variable, depending on the temperature of the cylinder head. During the normal operation of the engine,
the water valve opens the passage between the cylinder head and the heater and closes the passage
between the cylinder head and the tank. During preheat mode in which the cylinder head is heated, the
water valve opens the passage between the tank and the cylinder head, in order to allow the coolant to
flow from the tank to the cylinder head. At this time, in order to warm up the intake port quickly before the
engine is started, the coolant flows in the reverse direction.
The water valve for the coolant heat storage (CHS) system, which is located at the heater hoses, controls
the coolant passages to the engine, heater core, and the CHS tank in accordance with the operating
conditions of the system.
ES–306
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
The water valve consists of a water valve, valve position sensor, and valve control motor. The
potentiometer, which is coupled coaxially to the water valve, converts the valve position into voltage and
transmits it to the ECM in the form of a position signal.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P1120
Water valve position sensor voltage is less
than 0.2 V or more than 4.8 V
•
•
•
Open or short in water valve position
sensor circuit
Water valve (coolant flow control valve)
ECM
P1122
Water valve position sensor voltage stays less
than 0.2 V for 2 seconds or more
•
•
•
•
Water valve (coolant flow control valve)
Short in WBAD circuit
Open in VC circuit
ECM
P1123
Water valve position sensor voltage stays
more than 4.8 V for 2 seconds or more
•
•
•
•
•
Water valve (coolant flow control valve)
Short in WBAD circuit
Open in E2 circuit
VC and WBAD circuits are short-circuited
ECM
ES
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
Valve Position C
Valve Position B
Valve Position A
to Tank
to Heater
to Tank
to Tank to Heater
to Heater
to Engine
to Engine
Storage operation
(During Driving)
Preheat operation storage operation (after Power Switch OFF)
to Engine
No storage operation
(Engine Running)
A082804E01
A potentiometer is provided in the coolant heat storage (CHS) system. The ECM uses the valve position
signal output by the water valve for effecting control that is appropriate for the operating condition of the
engine. The water valve effects control in three steps as indicated below, and the ECM determines the
position of the valve according to the voltage of the respective step.
If the signal output by the water valve exceeds the normal range, the ECM determines that a malfunction
has occurred in the water valve position sensor circuit and outputs a DTC.
Water Valve Operation
System Condition
Valve Position
Coolant Flow
Normal engine operation
C
Engine to Cabin heater
Preheat mode
A
Coolant heat storage tank to Engine
Coolant recovering (after engine stop)
A
Engine to Coolant heat storage tank
Coolant recovering (while engine is running)
B
Engine to Cabin heater and Coolant heat
storage tank
Soak mode
A
Coolant heat storage tank to Engine
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–307
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
•
•
•
Required sensors/components
P1120: Coolant flow control valve (water valve) position sensor
circuit range check (fluttering)
P1122: Coolant flow control valve (water valve) position sensor
circuit range check (low voltage)
P1123: Coolant flow control valve (water valve) position sensor
circuit range check (high voltage)
Water valve position sensor
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
2 seconds
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
ES
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
None
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P1120:
Water valve position signal
Less than 0.2 V or more than 4.8 V
P1122:
Water valve position signal
Less than 0.2 V
P1123:
Water valve position signal
More than 4.8 V
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Water valve position signal
0.4 to 2.2 V
ES–308
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
Water Valve
WSL1
WSL1
WSL2
WSL2
WSAD
WBAD
ES
VC
VC
E2
E2
CHS Tank Outlet
Temperature Sensor
No. 2 Engine Room Relay Block
THW2
CHP W/P
WPL
E1
DC/DC
M CHS Water
CHS W/P
Engine Room Relay Block
Fusible
Link
Block
Pump
MAIN
A127922E03
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Although each DTC title says "Coolant Flow Control Valve", these DTCs are related to the water valve.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–309
CAUTION:
Be careful when replacing any part in the system or changing the coolant because the coolant in
the heat storage tank is hot even if the engine is cold.
HINT:
• To check the coolant heat storage (CHS) system, the ECM may cause the water pump of the CHS
system to operate 5 hours after the power switch has been turned OFF.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine condition
when malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the
vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or
rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
CHECK ECM (WBAD - E2 VOLTAGE)
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Measure voltage between the terminals WBAD and E2
of the E4 and E7 ECM connectors.
Standard voltage
E7
E4
Water Valve
E2
WBAD
ECM Connector
A124045E10
Specified Condition
Valve position "A" (Preheat mode)
Approximately 2.5 V
Valve position "B" (Recovering
mode)
Approximately 3.5 V
Valve position "C" (Normal
Operation)
Approximately 4.5 V
HINT:
After the HV main system is turned OFF (READY to IG
OFF condition), the valve position will be set to position
A.
OK
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
NG
2
INSPECT WATER M/BRACKET VALVE ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the W5 water valve connector.
(b) Measure resistance between terminals WSL1 and WSL2
of the water valve connector.
(c) Measure resistance between terminals WSAD and E2 of
the water valve connector.
Standard resistance
Component Side
Water Valve Connector
WSL2
WSL1
VC
W5
E2
Front View
WSAD
Tester Connection
Specification Condition
1 (WSL1) - 2 (WSL2)
Approximately 0.04 kΩ
5 (WSAD) - 6 (E2)
0.2 to 5.7 kΩ
A072922E10
NG
OK
REPLACE WATER W/BRACKET VALVE
ASSEMBLY
ES
ES–310
3
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (WATER VALVE - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the W5 water valve connector.
Wire Harness Side
Water Valve Connector
E2
W5
VC
WSAD
Front View
ES
E4
A075544E05
(b) Disconnect the E4 and E7 ECM connectors.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E7
Tester Connection
VC
E2
WBAD
ECM Connector
A082814E02
Specified Condition
W5-5 (Water valve) - E7-20 (WBAD)
Below 1 Ω
W5-4 (Water valve) - E4-18 (VC)
Below 1 Ω
W5-6 (Water valve) - E4-28 (E2)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
W5-5 (Water valve) or E7-20 (WBAD) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the water valve connector.
(e) Reconnect the ECM connectors.
NG
OK
REPLACE ECM
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
ES–311
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P1121
Coolant Flow Control Valve Position Sensor
Circuit Stuck
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P1120 (see page ES-298).
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P1121
•
•
•
•
•
•
Water valve position sensor output
voltage:
No change despite the ECM sending a
valve control signal or slow response
CHS tank outlet temperature sensor
output:
60°C (140°F) or more (when hot coolant
recovering starts)
CHS tank outlet temperature sensor
output:
No change despite the hot coolant is
recovered
Water valve
Cooling system (clogging)
ECM
ES
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
Valve Position A
Valve Position C
Valve Position B
to Tank
to Heater
to Tank
to Engine
Preheat operation storage operation (after Power Switch OFF)
to Heater
to Tank to Heater
to Engine
Storage operation
(During Driving)
to Engine
No storage operation
(Engine Running)
A082804E01
The ECM monitors the position of the water valve based on the valve position signal that is output by the
water valve position sensor (potentiometer), which is coupled coaxially to the valve. The water valve
effects control in three steps as indicated above, and the ECM determines the position of the valve
according to the voltage of the respective step.
In order to ensure the proper monitoring of the water valve, the ECM checks for malfunctions with the
combination of the output of the potentiometer and CHS tank outlet temperature sensor.
If no changes occur in the valve position signal that is being input into the ECM or if the response signal
from the water valve is very slow, despite of the ECM commanding the water valve motor to operate the
ECM determines that malfunction has occurred in the water valve position sensor circuit, and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Potentiometer detection
Related DTCs
P1121: Coolant flow control valve position sensor circuit stuck
Required sensors/components
Main:
Water valve
Related:
CHS tank outlet temperature sensor
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
ES–312
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Duration
20 seconds
MIL operation
2 driving cycle
Sequence of operation
None
Tank outlet coolant temperature detection
ES
Related DTCs
P1121: Coolant flow control valve position sensor circuit stuck
Required sensors/components
Main:
Water valve
Related:
CHS tank outlet temperature sensor
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
10 seconds
MIL operation
2 driving cycle
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
Potentiometer detection
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
None
Coolant heat storage system malfunction
Not detected
Battery voltage
10 V or more
Engine coolant temperature
0°C (32°F) or more
Water valve operation
Commanded
Response time of valve movement
Time under calculation with valve position
Tank outlet coolant temperature detection
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
None
Coolant heat storage system malfunction
Not detected
Battery voltage
10 V or more
System status
During recovering
CHS tank outlet temperature difference between preheating start and
engine start
20°C (36°F) or more
Difference between engine coolant temperature and CHS tank outlet
temperature
More than 30°C (54°F)
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Potentiometer detection
Either of the following conditions is met:
(a) or (b)
(a) Potentiometer output difference [D divided C]
C: Difference between previous and current target
D: Difference between potentiometer output and previous target
10% or more
(b) Potentiometer output deviation from target
0.1 V or more
Tank outlet coolant temperature detection
Either of the following conditions is met:
(a) or (b)
(a) Heat storage tank outlet coolant temperature when recover starts
60°C (108°F) or more
(b) Heat storage tank outlet coolant temperature difference during
water valve check
Less than 3°C (5.4°F)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P1120 (see page ES-301).
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–313
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Although each DTC title says "Coolant Flow Control Valve", these DTCs are related to the water valve.
• CHS stands for Coolant Heat Storage.
CAUTION:
Be careful when replacing any part in the system or changing the coolant because the coolant in
the heat storage tank is hot even if the engine is cold.
HINT:
• If DTCs P1121 and P1150 are detected simultaneously, there may be malfunction in the water valve
system.
• If DTC P1121 is detected, coolant passages may be clogged.
• To check the coolant heat storage (CHS) system, the ECM may cause the water pump of the CHS
system to operate 5 hours after the power switch has been turned OFF.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine condition
when malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the
vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or
rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
CHECK OTHER DTC OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P1121)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P1121
A
P1121 and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides P1121 are output, perform
troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
A
2
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the tester ON.
Put the engine in inspection mode (see page ES-1).
Start the engine and warm it up.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / WATER FLW VLV3, WATER
FLW VLV4 or WATER FLW VLV5.
(g) Measure the voltage between terminals WBAD and E2
of the ECM connector.
ES
ES–314
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Standard voltage
Tester Operation
Specified Condition
"WATER FLW VLV 3" ON
Approximately 2.5 V
"WATER FLW VLV 4" ON
Approximately 3.5 V
"WATER FLW VLV 5" ON
Approximately 4.5 V
NG
REPLACE WATER W/BRACKET VALVE
ASSEMBLY
OK
ES
3
CHECK COOLING SYSTEM (CHECK FOR CLOGGING IN THE COOLANT SYSTEM)
OK:
Coolant passages are not clogged.
NG
OK
REPLACE ECM
REPAIR OR REPLACE COOLING SYSTEM
ES–315
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P1150
Coolant Path Clog of Coolant Heat Storage System
DESCRIPTION
Coolant Heat Storage System (CHS System)
Coolant Flow
Water Pump for
Air Conditioner
Cabin Heater
Water Valve
Cylinder Head
ES
Coolant
Heat
Storage
Tank
Cylinder Block
Radiator
CHS Water
Pump
Coolant flow during preheat mode
ECM
Coolant flow during normal engine
operating
CHS Tank Outlet Temperature Sensor
A082803E01
This system uses an electric pump to supply hot coolant stored in the coolant heat storage (CHS) tank
into the cylinder head of the engine, in order to optimize engine starting combustion and reduce the
amount of unburned gas that is discharged while the engine is started. Before the engine starts, the ECM
operates the electric water pump to direct the hot coolant in the CHS tank into the engine, in order to heat
the cylinder head (this process is called "preheat mode"). The duration of the operation of the electric
water pump is variable, depending on the temperature of the cylinder head. During normal operation of
the engine, the water valve opens the passage between the cylinder head and the heater and closes the
passage between the cylinder head and the tank. During the preheat mode in which the cylinder head is
heated, the water valve opens the passage between the tank and the cylinder head, in order to allow the
coolant to flow from the tank to the cylinder head. At this time, in order to warm up the intake port quickly
before the engine is started, the coolant flows in the reverse direction.
This system consists of the CHS tank, CHS water pump, CHS tank outlet temperature sensor, water
valve, and a soak timer that is built in the ECM.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P1150
Following conditions are met:
• Change in CHS tank outlet temperature
and engine coolant temperature after
water pump is ON during preheat mode:
below 2°C (3.6°F)
• Change in CHS tank outlet temperature
as water valve is opened to tank, on a
warm engine: below 3°C (5.4°F)
•
•
•
•
CHS tank outlet temperature sensor
Water valve (coolant flow control valve)
Cooling system (clogging)
ECM
ES–316
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM detects malfunction in the coolant heat storage (CHS) system with the CHS tank outlet
temperature signal, the position of the water valve and the engine running condition. In order to ensure
the reliable malfunction detection, the ECM detects coolant passage clogging malfunction in two ways.
Thus, when the following two detection conditions are met, the ECM determines that the coolant passage
has clogged and sets a DTC.
• When starting the engine, a variation in the CHS tank outlet temperature and engine coolant
temperature before and after preheating is below 2°C (3.6°F).
• After the engine is warmed up, a variation in the CHS tank outlet temperature when the ECM opens the
water valve is below 3°C (5.4°F).
ES
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P1150: Coolant path clog up for coolant heat storage system
Required sensors/components (main)
CHS tank outlet temperature sensor
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
10 seconds
MIL operation
1 driving cycle
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
None
Coolant heat storage system malfunction
Not detected
Coolant heat storage water pump operation time
3 seconds or more
Variation in CHS tank coolant temperature and engine coolant
temperature before and after preheating
2°C (3.6°F) or less
Engine coolant temperature
65°C(149°F) or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Variation in CHS tank coolant temperature during passage clogging
check
Less than 3°C (5.4°F)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P1115 (see page ES-293).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
Be careful when replacing any part in the system or changing the coolant because the coolant in
the heat storage tank is hot even if the engine and the radiator are cold.
HINT:
• The detection of this DTC may indicate that the coolant heat storage (CHS) tank outlet water
temperature sensor stuck or the water valve stuck.
• If DTC P1121 is detected, coolant passages may be clogged.
• To check the coolant heat storage (CHS) system, the ECM may cause the water pump of the CHS
system to operate 5 hours after the power switch has been turned OFF.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine condition
when malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the
vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or
rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
1
ES–317
CHECK OTHER DTC OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P1150)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P1150
A
P1150 and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides P1150 are output, perform
troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
A
2
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
E7
E4
E2
WBAD
ECM Connector
A124045E10
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the tester ON.
Put the engine in inspection mode (see page ES-1).
Start the engine and warm it up.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / WATER FLW VLV3, WATER
FLW VLV4 or WATER FLW VLV5.
(g) Measure the voltage between terminals WBAD and E2
of the ECM connector.
Standard voltage
Tester Operation
Specified Condition
"WATER FLW VLV 3" ON
Approximately 2.5 V
"WATER FLW VLV 4" ON
Approximately 3.5 V
"WATER FLW VLV 5" ON
Approximately 4.5 V
NG
OK
REPLACE WATER W/BRACKET VALVE
ASSEMBLY
ES
ES–318
3
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
(a) Remove the CHS tank outlet temperature sensor.
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals.
Standard resistance
Ohmmeter
Resistance
kΩ
ES
Acceptable
Temperature °C (°F)
A081700E08
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1-2
2 to 3 kΩ at 20°C (68°F)
1-2
0.2 to 0.4 kΩ at 80°C (176°F)
NOTICE:
In case of checking the CHS tank outlet temperature
sensor in the water, be careful not to allow water to
contact the terminals. After checking, dry the sensor.
HINT:
Alternate procedure: Connect an ohmmeter to the
installed CHS tank outlet temperature sensor and read
the resistance. Use an infrared thermometer to measure
the CHS tank outlet temperature in the immediate vicinity
of the sensor. Compare these values to the resistance/
temperature graph. Change the engine temperature
(warm up or allow to cool down) and repeat the test.
(c) Reinstall the CHS tank outlet temperature sensor.
NG
REPLACE TEMPERATURE SENSOR
OK
CHECK COOLING SYSTEM (CHECK FOR CLOGGING IN THE COOLING SYSTEM)
ES–319
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P1151
Coolant Heat Storage Tank
DESCRIPTION
Coolant Heat Storage System (CHS System)
Coolant Flow
Water Pump for
Air Conditioner
Cabin Heater
Water Valve
Cylinder Head
ES
Coolant
Heat
Storage
Tank
Cylinder Block
Radiator
CHS Water
Pump
Coolant flow during preheat mode
ECM
Coolant flow during normal engine
operating
CHS Tank Outlet Temperature Sensor
A082803E01
This system uses an electric pump to supply hot coolant stored in the coolant heat storage (CHS) tank
into the cylinder head of the engine, in order to optimize engine starting combustion and reduce the
amount of unburned gas that is discharged while the engine is started. Before the engine starts, the ECM
operates the electric water pump to direct the hot coolant in the CHS tank into the engine, in order to heat
the cylinder head (this process is called "preheat mode"). The duration of the operation of the electric
water pump is variable, depending on the temperature of the cylinder head. During normal operation of
the engine, the water valve opens the passage between the cylinder head and the heater and closes the
passage between the cylinder head and the tank. During the preheat mode in which the cylinder head is
heated, the water valve opens the passage between the tank and the cylinder head, in order to allow the
coolant to flow from the tank to the cylinder head. At this time, in order to warm up the intake port quickly
before the engine is started, the coolant flows in the reverse direction.
This system consists of the CHS tank, CHS water pump, CHS tank outlet temperature sensor, water
valve, and a soak timer that is built in the ECM.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P1151
Following conditions are successively met:
• CHS tank outlet temperature during
preheating: below 50°C (122°F) (2 trip
detection condition)
• CHS tank outlet temperature during
soaking: 30°C (54°F) or more lower than
during coolant recovering
•
Coolant heat storage tank
ES–320
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
ES
The ECM detects malfunction in the coolant heat storage (CHS) system with the CHS tank coolant
temperature, the position of the water valve, the running condition of the engine and the operating
condition of the soak timer. The soak timer built in the ECM prompts the ECM to actuate the water pump 5
hours after the HV main system has been turned OFF by using the power switch. The ECM then checks
the heat retention condition of the CHS tank. In order to ensure the reliable malfunction detection, the
ECM detects the CHS tank heat retention malfunction in two ways. thus, when the following two detection
conditions are consecutively met, the ECM determines that the heat retention has deteriorated and sets a
DTC.
(1) During preheating, the CHS tank outlet water temperature is below 50°C (122°F) (2 trip detection
logic).
(2) During soaking, the CHS tank outlet temperature is more than 30°C (86°F) lower than that during the
got coolant recovery.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P1151: Coolant heat storage tank
Required sensors/components
CHS tank outlet temperature sensor
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
10 seconds
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
None
Coolant heat storage system malfunction
Not detected
Coolant heat storage water pump operation time
3 seconds or more
Storage coolant temperature
More than 65°C (149°F)
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Difference storage coolant temperature and heat storage tank outlet
coolant temperature
30°C (54°F) or more
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
Be careful when replacing any part in the system or changing the coolant because the coolant in
the heat storage tank is hot even if the engine and the radiator are cold.
NOTICE:
If air breeding is not performed completely, this DTC may be detected after changing the coolant.
HINT:
• To check the coolant heat storage (CHS) system, the ECM may cause the water pump of the CHS
system to operate 5 hours after the power switch has been turned OFF.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine condition
when malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the
vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or
rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
1
ES–321
REPLACE COOLANT HEAT STORAGE TANK
NEXT
REPAIR COMPLETED
ES
ES–322
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P1450
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor
DTC
P1451
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor Range/Performance
DTC
P1452
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor Low Input
DTC
P1453
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor High Input
DTC SUMMARY
ES
DTC No.
Monitoring Item
DTC Detection
Condition
P1450
Pressure sensor
abnormal voltage
fluctuation
Sensor output voltage
rapidly fluctuates beyond
upper and lower
malfunction thresholds
for 7 seconds.
P1451
Pressure sensor
abnormal voltage
fluctuation
Sensor output voltage
fluctuates frequently in
certain time period.
Trouble Area
•
•
Fuel tank pressure sensor
ECM
•
•
Fuel tank pressure sensor
Connector/wire harness
(Fuel tank pressure sensor
- ECM)
ECM
•
P1451
Pressure sensor
constant voltage
Sensor output voltage
does not vary in certain
time period.
•
•
•
P1452
Pressure sensor
voltage low
Sensor output is less
than -3,999 Pa for 7
seconds.
•
•
•
P1453
Pressure sensor
voltage high
Sensor output 1,999 Pa
for 7 seconds.
•
•
•
Detection Timing
Detection
Logic
•
Power switch ON
(IG)
1 trip
•
2 trips
•
EVAP monitoring
(power switch
OFF)
Engine running
•
Engine running)
2 trips
Fuel tank pressure sensor
Connector/wire harness
(Fuel tank pressure sensor
- ECM)
ECM
•
EVAP monitoring
(power switch
OFF)
Power switch ON
(IG)
1 trip
Fuel tank pressure sensor
Connector/wire harness
(Fuel tank pressure sensor
- ECM)
ECM
•
EVAP monitoring
(power switch
OFF)
Power switch ON
(IG)
1 trip
Fuel tank pressure sensor
Connector/wire harness
(Fuel tank pressure sensor
- ECM)
ECM
•
•
DESCRIPTION
NOTICE:
In this vehicle's EVAP system, turning ON the vent valve does not seal off the EVAP system. To
check for leaks in the EVAP system, disconnect the air inlet vent hose and apply pressure from
the atmosphere side of the canister.
While the engine is running, if a predetermined condition (closed loop, etc.) is met, the purge VSV is
opened by the ECM and stored fuel vapors in the canister are purged to the intake manifold. The ECM
changes the duty cycle ratio of the purge VSV to control purge flow volume.
The purge flow volume is also determined by the intake manifold pressure. Atmospheric pressure is
allowed into the canister through the vent valve to ensure that the purge flow is maintained when the
negative pressure (vacuum) is applied to the canister.
Key-off monitor
This monitor checks for Evaporative Emission (EVAP) system leaks and canister pump module
malfunctions. The monitor starts 5 hours* after the power switch is turned OFF. More than 5 hours are
required to allow the fuel to cool down to stabilize the Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP), thus making the EVAP
system monitor more accurate.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–323
The leak detection pump creates negative pressure (vacuum) in the EVAP system and the pressure is
measured. Finally, the ECM monitors for leaks from the EVAP system and malfunctions in both the
canister pump module and purge VSV, based on the EVAP pressure.
HINT:
*: If the engine coolant temperature is not below 35°C (95°F) 5 hours after the power switch is turned OFF,
the monitor check starts 2 hours later. If it is still not below 35°C (95°F) 7 hours after the power switch is
turned OFF, the monitor check starts 2.5 hours later.
ES
ES–324
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Location
EVAP Hose (From Canister)
Purge Line
ES
EVAP Hose (To Intake Manifold)
Purge VSV
Pump Module
Trap Canister
- Leak Detection Pump
- Canister Pressure Sensor
- Vent Valve
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor
Pressure Switching Valve
Canister Filter
Canister
Fuel Tank
Air Inlet Port
Fuel Cap
A131350E01
ES–325
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Diagram
Intake Manifold
Purge VSV
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor
Fuel Cap
Pressure Switching Valve
Fresh Air Line
ES
Canister
Fuel Pump Chamber
Canister Filter
Bladder Tank
Trap Canister with Pump Module
Outer Tank
Roll Over Valve
A130305E01
Pump Module
: Air Flow
Vent Valve (ON)
From
Canister
Filter
Trap Canister
Vent Valve (OFF)
Reference Orifice
Pressure Sensor
Leak Detection Pump (OFF)
Leak Detection Pump (ON)
A131438E01
ES–326
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Canister Pressure Sensor Specification
Malfunction Area
Output Voltage
4.900 V
4.150 V
Usable Range
ES
1.425 V
Malfunction Area
0.450 V
60 kPa
110 kPa
(450 mmHg) (825 mmHg)
Pressure
HINT:
Standard atmospheric pressure is 101.3 kPa (760mmHg)
A115543E09
Components
Operations
Canister, Trap canister
Contains activated charcoal to absorb EVAP generated in fuel tank.
Cut-off valve
Located in fuel tank. Valve floats and closes when fuel tank 100% full.
Purge Vacuum Switching Valve (VSV)
Opens or closes line between canister and intake manifold. ECM uses
purge VSV to control EVAP purge flow. In order to discharge EVAP
absorbed by canister to intake manifold, ECM opens purge VSV.
EVAP discharge volume to intake manifold controlled by purge VSV
duty cycle ratio (current-carrying time) (open: ON; closed: OFF).
Roll-over valve
Located in fuel tank. Valve closes by its own weight when vehicle
overturns to prevent fuel from spilling out.
Soak timer
Built into ECM. To ensure accurate EVAP monitor, measures 5 hours
(+-15 min) after power switch OFF. This allows fuel to cool down,
stabilizing Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP). When approximately 5 hours
elapsed, ECM activates.
Pressure switching valve
The pressure switching valve located on the canister is used to detect
leakage from the bladder tank into the fuel tank. The valve opens
during the bladder tank leak check. Then, the fuel tank's fuel vapor
flows to the intake manifold without passing the canister.
Pump module
Consists of (a) to (d) below. pump module cannot be disassembled.
(a) Vent valve
Vents and closes EVAP system. When ECM turns valve ON, EVAP
system closed. When ECM turns valve OFF, EVAP system vented.
Negative pressure (vacuum) created in EVAP system to check for
EVAP leaks by closing purge VSV, turning vent valve ON (closed) and
operating leak detection pump.
(b) Canister pressure sensor
Indicates pressure as voltage. ECM supplies regulated 5 V to canister
pressure sensor, and uses feedback from sensor to monitor EVAP
system pressure.
(c) Leak detection pump
Creates negative pressure (vacuum) in EVAP system for leak check.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Components
ES–327
Operations
Has opening with 0.02 inch diameter. Vacuum produced through
orifice by closing purge VSV, turning vent valve OFF and operating
leak detection pump to monitor 0.02 inch leak criterion. 0.02 inch leak
criterion indicates small leak of EVAP.
(d) Reference orifice
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
1. DTC P1451: Pressure sensor abnormal voltage fluctuation or being constant
If the pressure sensor output voltage fluctuates rapidly for 10 seconds, the ECM stops the EVAP
system monitor. The ECM interprets this as the pressure sensor voltage fluctuating, and stops the
EVAP system monitor. The ECM then illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC.
Alternatively, if the sensor output voltage does not change for 10 seconds, the ECM interprets this as
the sensor voltage being constant, and stops the monitor. The ECM then illuminates the MIL and sets
the DTC.
(Both the malfunctions are detected by 2 trip detection logic).
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor Specification
Output Voltage
Malfunction Area
4.9 V
4.5 V
2.14 V
Malfunction Area
0.5 V
0.45 V
-3.5
0
1.5
Pressure (kPa)
A109185E04
2. DTC P1452: Pressure sensor voltage low
If the pressure sensor output voltage is below 0.45 V, the ECM interprets this as an open or short circuit
malfunction in the pressure sensor or its circuit, and stops the EVAP system monitor. The ECM then
illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC (1 trip detection logic).
3. DTC P1453: Pressure sensor voltage high
If the pressure sensor voltage output is 4.9 V or more, the ECM interprets this as an open or short
circuit malfunction in the pressure sensor or its circuit, and stops the EVAP system monitor. The ECM
then illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC (1 trip detection logic).
MONITOR STRATEGY
Required Sensors/Components
Pump module
Frequency of Operation
Once per driving cycle: P1451 sensor constant voltage
Continuous: P1451 sensor abnormal voltage fluctuation, P1452 and
P1453
Duration
Within 10 seconds
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
P1450, P1452, P1453:
Engine
Running
Time after engine start
Less than 10 seconds
ES
ES–328
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ECT at engine start
10 to 35°C (50 to 95°F)
IAT at engine start
10 to 35°C (50 to 95°F)
ECT at engine start - IAT at engine start
Less than 12°C (53.6°F)
P1451:
ES
Altitude
Less than 2,400 m (8,000 ft.)
Battery voltage
11 V or higher
Conditions
Power switch ON (IG) and DLC3 connector OFF
or
OBD check mode ON and idle ON
Throttle position learning
Completed
Canister pressure sensor
No malfunction
IAT at engine start - ECT at engine start
-7 to 11.1°C (19.4 to 52°F)
Purge VSV and pressure switching valve
Not operated by scan tool
ECT at engine start
4.4 to 35°C (40 to 95°F)
IAT at engine start
4.4 to 35°C (40 to 95°F)
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P1450:
Fuel tank pressure
Less than -3,999 Pa (-30 mmHg) or 1,999 Pa (15 mmHg) or more
P1451 (Noise Monitor):
Sensor output change 0.667 kPa or more during 5 to 15 seconds after
idling and vehicle stop
7 times or more
P1451 (Stuck Monitor):
Not to make pass determination
20 minutes or more
P1452:
Fuel tank pressure
Less than -3,999 Pa (-30 mmHg)
P1453:
Fuel tank pressure
1,999 Pa (15 mmHg) or more
ES–329
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor
PTNK
PTNK
VCC
VC
E2
E2
ES
Purge VSV
Pump Module
EVP1
VCC
SGND
PPMP
VOUT
MPMP
MTRB
VGND
Pressure Switching Valve
VPMP
TBP
VLVB
EFI M
MGND
EFI
MREL
P/I
MAIN
Battery
A127937E01
ES–330
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
• When a vehicle is brought into the workshop, leave it as it is. Do not change the vehicle
condition. For example, do not tighten the fuel tank cap.
• Do not disassemble the pump module.
• The intelligent tester is required to conduct the following diagnostic troubleshooting
procedure.
1
CONFIRM DTC AND FUEL TANK PRESSURE
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the tester on.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
(f) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DATA LIST / EVAP / VAPOR PRESS TANK.
(g) Read the EVAP (Evaporative Emission) pressure
displayed on the tester.
ES
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Test Result
P1451
-
P1450 and/or P1452
Suspected Trouble Area
Less than -17.187 kPa (-128.93 mmHg)
•
Pressure sensor
C
•
Wire harness/connector (ECM pressure sensor)
Pressure sensor
Short in ECM circuit
A
Wire harness/connector (ECM pressure sensor)
Pressure sensor
Open in ECM circuit
B
•
•
•
P1450 and/or P1453
More than 23.5 kPa (176.69 mmHg)
B
C
Proceed to
•
•
Go to step 4
GO TO EVAP INSPECTION PROCEDURE
A
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (FUEL TANK PRESSURE SENSOR - ECM)
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the PTNK terminal of
the ECM connector and the body ground.
E7
PTNK
ECM Connector
A065744E69
ES–331
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Result
Test Result
Suspected Trouble Area
•
10 Ω or less
•
•
10 kΩ or more
•
Proceed to
Wire harness/connector (ECM pressure sensor)
Short in pressure sensor circuit
A
Wire harness/connector (ECM pressure sensor)
Short in ECM (included in HV Control
ECU) circuit
B
(d) Reconnect the ECM connector.
B
Go to step 7
A
3
ES
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (FUEL TANK PRESSURE SENSOR - ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Remove the fuel tank assembly.
Disconnect the V6 fuel tank pressure sensor connector.
Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
Measure the resistance between the PTNK terminal of
the ECM connector and the body ground.
E7
ECM Connector
PTNK
A131349E01
Result
Test Result
Suspected Trouble Area
Proceed to
10 kΩ or more
•
Short in pressure sensor circuit
A
10 Ω or less
•
Short in wire harness/connector (ECM
- pressure sensor)
B
(e) Reconnect the pressure sensor connector.
(f) Reconnect the ECM connector.
A
Go to step 5
B
Go to step 6
ES–332
4
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (FUEL TANK PRESSURE SENSOR - ECM)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Wire Harness Side:
V6
Remove the fuel tank assembly.
Disconnect the V6 fuel tank pressure sensor connector.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Measure the voltage and resistance according to the
value(s) in the table below.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V6-3 - Body ground
4.5 to 5.0 V
Standard resistance
ES
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V6-2 - Body ground
100 Ω or less
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor Connector
A109175E02
Result
Test Result
Voltage and resistance within standard
ranges
Voltage and resistance outside standard
ranges
Suspected Trouble Area
Proceed to
•
Open in pressure sensor circuit
A
•
Open in wire harness/connector (ECM
- pressure sensor)
B
(e) Reconnect the canister connector.
B
Go to step 6
A
5
REPLACE FUEL TANK PRESSURE SENSOR
NEXT
6
Go to step 8
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
HINT:
If the exhaust tail pipe has been removed, go to the next step
before reinstalling it.
7
NEXT
Go to step 8
NEXT
Go to step 8
REPLACE ECM
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
8
ES–333
CHECK WHETHER DTC OUTPUT RECURS (AFTER REPAIR)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
NEXT
COMPLETED
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG) and turn the tester on.
Wait for at least 60 seconds.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / PENDING CODES.
HINT:
If no pending DTC is displayed on the tester, the repair
has been successfully completed.
ES
ES–334
DTC
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
P1455
Vapor Reducing Fuel Tank System Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
Using the heated oxygen sensor and pressure switching VSV, the ECM detects fuel leaks from inside a
bladder tank the fuel tank.
Based on signals from the heated oxygen sensor while the VSV for purge flow switching valve is ON, the
ECM judges if fuel is leaked from the bladder tank or not.
ES
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P1455
When VSV for purge flow switching valve is
ON, vapor density of air which flows from
purge VSV into intake manifold is high
•
•
•
Hose and pipe for EVAP system
Fuel system
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM detects leakage of evaporative emissions from the bladder membrane by using the heated
oxygen sensor and pressure switching valve. By opening the purge VSV and then closing the pressure
switching valve, air in the outer tank is drawn into the intake manifold.
The ECM checks concentration of hydrocarbon (HC) molecules in the air drawn from the bladder
membrane area. Also, the ECM checks the sensor output before and after closing the pressure switching
valve. If there is change in the HC concentration when the pressure switching valve is opened or closed,
the ECM will conclude that the bladder membrane is leaking. The ECM will illuminates the MIL and a DTC
is set.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P1455: Vapor reducing fuel tank system leak detected (small leak)
monitor
Required sensors/components (main)
Fuel tank
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
None
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
Monitor runs whenever following DTC not present
None
Engine
Running
ECT
4.4°C (40°F) or more
IAT
4.4°C (40°F) or more
EVAP control system pressure sensor malfunction
Not detected
Purge VSV
Not detected by scan tool
EVAP system check
Not detected by scan tool
Battery voltage
11 V or higher
Purge duty cycle
15% or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Vapor concentration in purge air
Less than -7 to -4% (depending on intake air temperature)
FAF smoothing value
Less than 5%
VSV for purge flow switching valve
No malfunction
Purge air volume after purge flow switching valve monitoring
2 g or more
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–335
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to detailed information (see page ES-15).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine condition when
malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was
running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or rich, and other data
from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
CHECK OTHER DTC OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P1455)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P1455
A
P1455 and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides P1455 are output, perform
troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
A
2
INSPECT FUEL TANK ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the fuel tank (see page FU-23).
(b) Drain fuel from the tank and turn it upside down.
OK:
Fuel does not come out from anywhere except the
main fuel hose.
OK
NG
REPLACE FUEL TANK ASSEMBLY
REPLACE ECM
ES
ES–336
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P2102
Throttle Actuator Control Motor Circuit Low
DTC
P2103
Throttle Actuator Control Motor Circuit High
DESCRIPTION
The throttle motor is operated by the ECM and it opens and closes the throttle valve.
The opening angle of the throttle valve is detected by the throttle position sensor which is mounted on the
throttle body. The throttle position sensor provides feedback to the ECM. This feedback allows the ECM to
control the throttle motor and monitor the throttle opening angle as the ECM responds to driver inputs.
HINT:
This Electrical Throttle Control System (ETCS) does not use a throttle cable.
ES
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P2102
Conditions (a) and (b) continue for 2.0
seconds:
(a) Throttle control motor output duty is 80%
or more
(b) Throttle control motor current is less than
0.5 A
•
•
•
Open in throttle control motor circuit
Throttle control motor
ECM
P2103
Following conditions are met.
• Hybrid IC diagnosis signal: Fail
• Hybrid IC current limiter port: Fail
When electric throttle actuator is ON (i.e.
actuator power ON or actuator power
supply voltage is 8 V or more)
•
•
•
•
•
Short in throttle control motor circuit
Throttle control motor
Throttle valve
Throttle body assembly
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM monitors the flow of electrical current through the electronic throttle motor, and detects
malfunction or open circuits in the throttle motor based on the value of the electrical current. When the
current deviates from the standard values, the ECM concludes that there is a fault in the throttle motor. Or,
if the throttle valve is not functioning properly (for example, stuck ON), the ECM concludes that there is a
fault in the throttle motor and turns on the MIL and a DTC is set.
Example:
When the current is more than 10 A. Or, the current is less than 0.5 A when the motor driving duty ratio is
more than 80%. The ECM concludes that the current is deviated from the standard values, turns on the
MIL and a DTC is set.
FAIL-SAFE
If the Electronic Throttle Control System (ETCS) has a malfunction, the ECM cuts off current to the throttle
control motor. The throttle control valve returns to a predetermined opening angle (approximately 16°) by
the force of the return spring. The ECM then adjusts the engine output by controlling the fuel injection
(intermittent fuel-cut) and ignition timing in accordance with the accelerator pedal opening angle to enable
the vehicle to continue to drive.
If the accelerator pedal is depressed firmly and slowly, the vehicle can be driven slowly.
If a "pass" condition is detected and then the power switch is turned OFF, the fail-safe operation will stop
and the system will return to normal condition.
MONITOR STRATEGY
P2102: Throttle actuator control motor current (low current)
Related DTCs
P2102: Throttle actuator control motor current (low current)
Required sensors/components
Throttle actuator motor
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
2 seconds
MIL operation
Immediately
ES–337
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Sequence of operation
None
P2103: Throttle actuator control motor current (high current)
Related DTCs
P2103: Throttle actuator control motor current (high current)
Required sensors/components
Throttle actuator motor
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
0.6 seconds
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
P2102: Throttle actuator control motor current (low current)
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
None
Throttle motor
ON
Difference between motor current of present and 0.016 second ago
Less than 0.2 A
ES
P2103: Throttle actuator control motor current (high current)
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
None
Throttle motor
ON
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P2102: Throttle actuator control motor current (low current)
Throttle motor current
Less than 0.5 A (when motor drive duty is 80% or more)
P2103: Throttle actuator control motor current (high current)
Hybrid IC
Fail
WIRING DIAGRAM
Throttle Body Assembly
(Throttle Control Motor)
ECM
M+
M+
M-
MShielded
Motor Control
Circuit
GE01
A115327E04
ES–338
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine condition when
malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was
running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or rich, and other data
from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
INSPECT THROTTLE W/MOTOR BODY ASSEMBLY (THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR)
(a) Disconnect the throttle control motor connector.
(b) Measure the motor resistance between terminals 1 (M-)
and 2 (M+).
Standard resistance
Component Side
Throttle Control Motor Connector
ES
T2
M+
M-
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1 (M-) - 2 (M+)
0.3 to 100 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
NG
A088591E01
REPLACE THROTTLE W/MOTOR BODY
ASSEMBLY
OK
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (ECM - THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR)
(a) Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
E5
M+
M-
ECM Connector
A065745E46
(b) Disconnect the T2 throttle control motor connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Wire Harness Side
Throttle Control Motor Connector
T2
M-
Front View
M+
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
2 (Throttle control motor) - E5-6 (M+)
Below 1 Ω
1 (Throttle control motor) - E5-5 (M-)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
A053155E03
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
2 (Throttle control motor) or E5-6
(M+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
1 (Throttle control motor) or E5-5 (M-)
- Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the ECM connector and the throttle control
motor connector.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
NG
ES–339
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
3
INSPECT THROTTLE W/MOTOR BODY ASSEMBLY
(a) Visually check between the throttle valve and the
housing for foreign objects.
Also, check if the valve can open and close smoothly.
OK:
The throttle valve is not contaminated by foreign
objects and can move smoothly.
NG
OK
REPLACE ECM
REMOVE FOREIGN OBJECT AND CLEAN
THROTTLE BODY
ES
ES–340
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P2111
Throttle Actuator Control System - Stuck Open
DTC
P2112
Throttle Actuator Control System - Stuck
Closed
DESCRIPTION
ES
The throttle motor is operated by the ECM and it opens and closes the throttle valve using gears. The
opening angle of the throttle valve is detected by the throttle position sensor, which is mounted on the
throttle body. The throttle position sensor provides to ECM with feedback to control the throttle motor and
set the throttle valve angle in response to driver input.
HINT:
This Electrical Throttle Control System (ETCS) does not use a throttle cable.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P2111
Throttle motor locked during ECM orders to
open
•
•
•
•
Throttle control motor circuit
Throttle control motor
Throttle body
Throttle valve
P2112
Throttle motor locked during ECM orders to
close
•
•
•
•
Throttle control motor circuit
Throttle control motor
Throttle body
Throttle valve
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM concludes that there is malfunction of the ETCS when the throttle valve remains at a fixed angle
despite high drive current supplying from the ECM. The ECM will turn on the MIL and a DTC is set.
FAIL-SAFE
If the Electronic Throttle Control System (ETCS) has malfunction, the ECM cuts off current to the throttle
control motor. The throttle control valve returns to a predetermined opening angle (approximately 16°) by
the force of the return spring. The ECM then adjusts the engine output by controlling the fuel injection
(intermittent fuel-cut) and ignition timing in accordance with the accelerator pedal opening angle to enable
the vehicle to continue to drive.
If the accelerator pedal is depressed firmly and slowly, the vehicle can be driven slowly.
If a "pass" condition is detected and then the power switch is turned OFF, the fail-safe operation will stop
and the system will return to normal condition.
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
Related DTCs
P2111: Throttle motor actuator lock (open)
P2112: Throttle motor actuator lock (closed)
Main sensors/components
Throttle actuator motor
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
0.5 seconds
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
P2111:
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
None
Throttle motor current
2 A or more
Throttle motor duty to open
80% or more
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–341
P2112:
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
None
Throttle motor current
2 A or more
Throttle motor duty to close
80% or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Difference between throttle position sensor output voltage of present
and 16 milliseconds ago
Less than 0.1 V
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P2102 (see page ES-330).
ES
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine condition when
malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was
running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or rich, and other data
from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
CHECK OTHER DTC OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P2111 AND/OR P2112)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC output)
Proceed to
P2111 or P2112
A
P2111 or P2112, and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides P2111 and/or P2112 are
output, perform troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
A
2
INSPECT THROTTLE W/MOTOR BODY ASSEMBLY (VISUALLY CHECK THROTTLE
VALVE)
(a) Check for contamination between the throttle valve and
the housing. If necessary, clean the throttle body. And
check that the throttle valve moves smoothly.
B
OK
REPLACE THROTTLE W/MOTOR BODY
ASSEMBLY
ES–342
3
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK IF DTC OUTPUT RECURS (DTC P2111 AND/OR P2112)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the tester ON.
Clear the DTC.
Put the engine in inspection mode (see page ES-1).
Start the engine, and depress and release the
accelerator pedal quickly (fully open and fully close).
(g) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(h) Start the engine, and depress and release the
accelerator pedal quickly (fully open and fully close).
(i) Read DTCs.
Result
ES
Display (DTC output)
Proceed to
No output
A
P2111 and/or P2112
B
B
A
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
REPLACE ECM
ES–343
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P2118
Throttle Actuator Control Motor Current Range
/ Performance
DESCRIPTION
The Electronic Throttle Control System (ETCS) has a dedicated power supply circuit. The voltage (+BM)
is monitored and when the voltage is low (less than 4 V), the ECM concludes that the ETCS has a fault
and current to the throttle control motor is cut.
When the voltage becomes unstable, the ETCS itself becomes unstable. For this reason, when the
voltage is low, the current to the motor is cut. If repairs are made and the system has returned to normal,
turn the power switch OFF. The ECM then allows current to flow to the motor and the motor can be
restarted.
HINT:
This Electrical Throttle Control System (ETCS) does not use a throttle cable.
ECM
ETCS Fuse
From
Battery
+BM
Throttle Control Motor
Motor
Control
Circuit
+M
-M
ME01
A085832E07
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P2118
Open in ETCS power source circuit
•
•
•
Open in ETCS power source circuit
ETCS fuse
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM monitors the battery supply voltage applied to the electronic throttle motor. When the power
supply voltage drops below the threshold, the ECM concludes that there is an open in the power supply
circuit. A DTC is set and the MIL is turned on.
FAIL-SAFE
If the Electronic Throttle Control System (ETCS) has malfunction, the ECM cuts off current to the throttle
control motor. The throttle control valve returns to a predetermined opening angle (approximately 16°) by
the force of the return spring. The ECM then adjusts the engine output by controlling the fuel injection
(intermittent fuel-cut) and ignition timing in accordance with the accelerator pedal opening angle to enable
the vehicle to continue to drive.
If the accelerator pedal is depressed firmly and slowly, the vehicle can be driven slowly.
ES
ES–344
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
If a "pass" condition is detected and then the power switch is turned OFF, the fail-safe operation will stop
and the system will return to normal condition.
MONITOR STRATEGY
ES
Related DTCs
P2118: Throttle actuator motor power supply line range check (low
voltage)
Required sensors/components
Throttle actuator motor
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
0.8 seconds
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
None
Actuator power
ON
Battery voltage
8 V or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Throttle actuator motor power supply voltage
Less than 4 V
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Throttle actuator motor power supply voltage
9 to 14 V
ES–345
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
ETCS
+BM
Motor Control
Circuit
ES
MAIN
E1
A128754E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine condition when
malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was
running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or rich, and other data
from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
INSPECT FUSE (ETCS FUSE)
(a) Remove the ETCS fuse from the engine room relay
block.
(b) Check the resistance of the ETCS fuse.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
(c) Reinstall the ETCS fuse.
Engine Room Relay Block
NG
ETCS Fuse
A088592E01
OK
CHECK FOR SHORT IN ALL HARNESS AND
COMPONENTS CONNECTED FUSE
ES–346
2
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK ECM (+BM VOLTAGE)
(a) Measure the voltage between the specified terminals of
the E5 and E7 ECM connectors.
Standard voltage
E7
E5
Specified Condition
E7-5 (+BM) - E5-28 (E1)
9 to 14 V
OK
E1
+BM
ECM Connector
ES
Tester Connection
REPLACE ECM
A124045E11
NG
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (ECM - ETCS FUSE, ETCS FUSE - BATTERY)
(a) Check the harness and the connectors between the
ETCS fuse and the ECM connector.
(1) Remove the ETCS fuse from the engine room relay
block.
Engine Room Relay Block
ETCS Fuse
A093905E01
(2) Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
(3) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E7
+BM
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
2 (ETCS fuse) - E7-5 (+BM)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
ECM Connector
A065744E35
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
2 (ETCS fuse) or + E7-5 (BM) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(4) Reinstall the ETCS fuse.
(5) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(b) Check the harness and the connectors between the
ETCS fuse and the battery.
(1) Remove the ETCS fuse from the engine room relay
block.
(2) Disconnect the positive battery terminal.
(3) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Battery positive terminal - 1 (ETCS
fuse)
Below 1 Ω
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–347
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Battery positive terminal or 1 (ETCS
fuse) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(4) Reinstall the ETCS fuse.
(5) Reconnect the positive battery terminal.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
CHECK AND REPLACE FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK ASSEMBLY
ES
ES–348
DTC
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
P2119
Throttle Actuator Control Throttle Body Range /
Performance
DESCRIPTION
The Electric Throttle Control System (ETCS) is composed of a throttle motor that operates the throttle
valve, a throttle position sensor that detects the opening angle of the throttle valve, an accelerator pedal
position sensor that detects the accelerator pedal position, and the ECM that controls the ETCS system.
The ECM operates the throttle motor to position the throttle valve for proper response to driver inputs. The
throttle position sensor, mounted on the throttle body, provides this signal to the ECM so that the ECM can
regulate the throttle motor.
ES
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P2119
Throttle opening angle continues to vary
greatly from its target angle
•
•
Electric throttle control system
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM determines the "actual" throttle valve angle based on the throttle position sensor signal. The
"actual" throttle valve position is compared to the "target" throttle valve position commanded by the ECM.
If the difference of these two values exceeds a specified limit, the ECM interprets this as a fault in the
ETCS system. The ECM turns on the MIL and a DTC is set.
FAIL-SAFE
If the Electronic Throttle Control System (ETCS) has malfunction, the ECM cuts off current to the throttle
control motor. The throttle control valve returns to a predetermined opening angle (approximately 16°) by
the force of the return spring. The ECM then adjusts the engine output by controlling the fuel injection
(intermittent fuel-cut) and ignition timing in accordance with the accelerator pedal opening angle to enable
the vehicle to continue to drive.
If the accelerator pedal is depressed firmly and slowly, the vehicle can be driven slowly.
If a "pass" condition is detected and then the power switch is turned OFF, the fail-safe operation will stop
and the system will return to normal condition.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2119: Electronic throttle control system failure
Required sensors/components
Main:
Throttle actuator motor
Related:
Throttle position sensor
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
Within 1 second
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
None
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Difference between commanded throttle valve position and current
throttle valve position
0.3 V or more
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–349
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Commanded throttle valve position
Same as current throttle valve position
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P2102 (see page ES-330).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine condition when
malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was
running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or rich, and other data
from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
CHECK OTHER DTC OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P2119)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P2119
A
P2119 and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides P2119 are output, perform
troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
A
2
CHECK IF DTC OUTPUT RECURS
(a) Clear the DTCs (see page ES-29).
(b) Allow the engine to idle for 15 seconds.
(c) Securely apply the parking brake, and place the shift
position in D.
(d) Depress the brake pedal securely and the accelerator
pedal fully for 5 seconds.
(e) Read DTCs.
HINT:
Actual throttle position (TP) sensor voltage can be
confirmed using the intelligent tester [DATA LIST / USER
DATA /THROTTLE POS #1].
OK:
No DTC output.
OK
SYSTEM OK
ES
ES–350
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
NG
REPLACE THROTTLE W/MOTOR BODY ASSEMBLY
ES
ES–351
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P2195
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Signal Stuck Lean (Bank 1
Sensor 1)
DTC
P2196
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Signal Stuck Rich (Bank 1
Sensor 1)
DESCRIPTION
The air-fuel ratio (A/F) sensor provides output voltage* which is almost equal to the existing air-fuel ratio.
The A/F sensor output voltage is used to provide feedback for the ECM to control the air-fuel ratio.
With the A/F sensor output, the ECM can determine deviation from the stoichiometric air-fuel ratio and
control proper injection time. If the A/F sensor is malfunctioning, the ECM is unable to accurately control
the air-fuel ratio.
The A/F sensor is equipped with a heater which heats the zirconia element. The heater is also controlled
by the ECM. When the intake air volume is low (the temperature of the exhaust gas is low), current flows
to the heater to heat the sensor to facilitate detection of accurate oxygen concentration.
The A/F sensor is a planar type. Compared to a conventional type, the sensor and heater portions are
narrower. Because the heat of the heater is conducted through the alumina to zirconia (of the sensor
portion), sensor activation is accelerated.
To obtain a high purification rate of carbon monoxides (CO), hydrocarbons (HC) and nitrogen oxides
(NOx) components of the exhaust gas, a three-way catalytic converter is used. The converter is most
efficient when the air-fuel ratio is maintained near the stoichiometric air-fuel ratio.
*: The voltage value changes inside the ECM only.
ECM Monitored
A/F Sensor Voltage
Solid Electrolyte
(Zirconia Element)
Alumina
Heater
Platinum Electrode
Cover
Element
Exhaust Gas
A
A
Atmospheric Air
A-A Cross Section
Air-fuel Ratio
A073819E02
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P2195
Conditions (a) and (b) continue for 2 seconds
or more :
(a) A/F sensor voltage is more than 3.8 V.
(b) Rear oxygen sensor voltage is 0.15 V or
more.
•
A/F sensor current is 3.6 mA or more.
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 1
sensor 1) circuit
A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
A/F sensor heater
Integration relay
A/F sensor heater and relay circuit
Air induction system
Fuel pressure
Injector
PCV hose connection
ECM
ES
ES–352
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P2196
Conditions (a) and (b) continue for 2 seconds
or more :
(a) A/F sensor voltage is less than 2.8 V.
(b) Rear oxygen sensor voltage is less than
0.6 V.
•
A/F sensor current is less than 1.4 mA.
ES
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 1
sensor 1) circuit
A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
A/F sensor heater
Integration relay
A/F sensor heater and relay circuit
Air induction system
Fuel pressure
Injector
PCV hose connection
ECM
HINT:
• Sensor 1 refers to the sensor closest to the engine assembly.
• After confirming DTC P2195 and P2196, use the intelligent tester to confirm voltage output of A/F
sensor (AFS B1 S1) from the "DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / DATA LIST / PRIMARY."
• The A/F sensor's output voltage and the short-term fuel trim value can be read using the intelligent
tester.
• The ECM controls the voltage of the A1A+, and A1A- terminals of the ECM to a fixed voltage.
Therefore, it is impossible to confirm the A/F sensor output voltage without the intelligent tester.
• The OBD II scan tool (excluding the intelligent tester) displays the one fifth of the A/F sensor output
voltage which is displayed on the intelligent tester.
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
Under the air-fuel ratio feedback control, if the voltage output of the A/F sensor indicates RICH or LEAN
for a certain period of time or more, the ECM concludes that there is a fault in the A/F sensor system. The
ECM will turn on the MIL and a DTC is set.
If the A/F sensor voltage output is less than 2.8 V (indicates very RICH) 10 seconds even though voltage
output of the heated oxygen sensor output voltage is less than 0.6 V, the ECM sets DTC P2196 Also, if
the heated oxygen sensor output voltage is 0.15 V or more, but the A/F sensor voltage output is more
than 3.8 V (indicates very LEAN) for 10 seconds, DTC P2195 or is set.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2195: A/F sensor signal stuck lean
P2196: A/F sensor signal stuck rich
Required sensors/components
Main: A/F sensor
Related: Heated oxygen sensor
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
10 seconds
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of operation
None
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–353
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
All:
Monitor runs whenever following DTCs not present
P0031, P0032 (A/F sensor heater - Sensor 1)
P0037, P0038 (O2 sensor heater - Sensor 2)
P0100 - P0103 (MAF meter)
P0110 - P0113 (IAT sensor)
P0115 - P0118 (ECT sensor)
P0120 - P0223, P2135 (TP sensor)
P0125 (Insufficient ECT for Closed Loop)
P0136 (O2 sensor - sensor 2)
P0171, P0172 (Fuel system)
P0300 - P0304 (Misfire)
P0335 (CKP sensor)
P0340 (CMP sensor)
P0455, P0456 (EVAP system)
P0500 (VSS)
Sensor voltage detection monitor (Lean side malfunction P2195):
Duration while all of following conditions met
2 seconds or more
Rear HO2 sensor voltage
0.15 V or more
Time after engine start
30 seconds or more
A/F sensor status
Activated
Fuel system status
Closed-loop
Engine
Running
Sensor voltage detection monitor (Rich side malfunction P2196):
Duration while all of following conditions met
2 seconds or more
Rear HO2 sensor voltage
Below 0.6 V
Time after engine start
30 seconds or more
A/F sensor status
Activated
Fuel system status
Closed-loop
Engine
Running
Sensor current detection monitor P2195 and P2196:
Battery voltage
11 V or more
Atmospheric pressure
76 kPa (570 mmHg) or more
A/F sensor status
Activated
Continuous time of fuel cut
3 to 10 seconds
ECT
75°C (167°F) or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Sensor voltage detection monitor (Lean side malfunction P2195)
A/F sensor output voltage
More than 3.8 V
Sensor voltage detection monitor (Rich side malfunction P2196)
A/F sensor output voltage
Less than 2.8 V
Sensor current detection monitor P2195
A/F sensor current
3.6 mA or more
Sensor current detection monitor P2196
A/F sensor current
Less than 1.4 mA
ES
ES–354
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
Engine Room
Relay Block
MREL
Air Fuel Ratio Sensor
(Bank 1 Sensor 1)
Shielded
EFI M
ES
HA1A
EFI
A1A+
P/I
A1AMAIN
E1
A127920E01
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
Vehicle Speed
(e)
70 to 120 km/h
(44 to 75 mph)
Idling
(d)
Power Switch OFF
(a), (b)
2 minutes
5 to 10 minutes
Time
A079199E59
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Switch the ECM from normal mode to check mode using the intelligent tester (see page ES-29).
ES–355
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(c) Put the engine in inspection mode (see page ES-1).
(d) Start the engine and warm it up with all the accessory switches OFF.
(e) Deactivate the inspection mode and drive the vehicle at 70 to 120 km/h (44 to 75 mph) for 5 to 10
minutes (the engine must be run during monitoring).
HINT:
If malfunction exists, the MIL will be illuminated during step (d).
NOTICE:
• If the conditions in this test are not strictly followed, no malfunction will be detected. If you do
not have the intelligent tester, turn the power switch OFF after performing steps (d) and (e),
then perform steps (d) and (e) again.
• Do not drive the vehicle without deactivating inspection mode, otherwise damaging the
transaxle may result.
ES
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Although each DTC title says "oxygen sensor", these DTCs are related to the A/F sensor.
• Malfunctioning areas can be found by performing the ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL operation. The
A/F CONTROL operation can determine if the A/F sensor, heated oxygen sensor or other potential
trouble area are malfunctioning or not.
(a) Perform the ACTIVE TEST A/F CONTROL operation.
HINT:
The A/F CONTROL operation lowers the injection volume 12.5% or increases the injection volume 25%.
(1) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(3) Put the engine in inspection mode (see page ES-1).
(4) Warm up the engine by running the engine at 2,500 rpm, depressing the accelerator pedal more than
60% for approximately 90 seconds.
(5) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL.
(6) Perform the A/F CONTROL operation with the engine in an idle condition (press the right or left
button).
Result:
A/F sensor reacts in accordance with increase and decrease of injection volume:
+25% → rich output: Less than 3.0 V
-12.5% → lean output: More than 3.35 V
Heated oxygen sensor reacts in accordance with increase and decrease of injection volume:
+25% → rich output: More than 0.55 V
-12.5% → lean output: Less than 0.4 V
NOTICE:
The A/F sensor output has a few seconds of delay and the heated oxygen sensor output has about
20 seconds of delay at maximum.
Case
A/F Sensor (Sensor 1) Output Voltage
HO2 Sensor (Sensor 2) Output Voltage
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
Output Voltage
More than 0.55 V
Less than 0.4 V
Main Suspected
Trouble Area
-
1
ES–356
Case
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
A/F Sensor (Sensor 1) Output Voltage
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Output Voltage
More than 0.55 V
Less than 0.4 V
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
2
3
ES
Main Suspected
Trouble Area
HO2 Sensor (Sensor 2) Output Voltage
4
•
•
•
A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
A/F sensor circuit
•
•
•
HO2 sensor
HO2 sensor heater
HO2 sensor circuit
•
•
•
Fuel Injector
Fuel pressure
Gas leakage from
exhaust system (Airfuel ratio extremely
or lean rich)
The following A/F CONTROL procedure enables the technician to check and graph the voltage output of
both A/F sensor and heated oxygen sensor.
To display the graph, enter ACTIVE TEST/ A/F CONTROL/USER DATA, select "AFS B1S1 and O2S
B1S2" by pressing the "YES" button followed by the "ENTER" button and then the "F4" button.
HINT:
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine condition
when malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the
vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or
rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
• A high A/F sensor voltage could be caused by a RICH air-fuel mixture. Check the conditions that would
cause the engine to run with the RICH air-fuel mixture.
• A low A/F sensor voltage could be caused by a LEAN air-fuel mixture. Check the conditions that would
cause the engine to run with the LEAN air-fuel mixture.
1
CHECK OTHER DTC OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC A/F SENSOR DTCS)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC output)
Proceed to
A/F sensor circuit DTC
A
A/F sensor circuit DTCs and other
DTCs
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides A/F sensor DTCs are output,
perform troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
B
ES–357
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
A
2
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (OUTPUT VOLTAGE OF A/F SENSOR)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC 3.
(b) Put the engine in inspection mode (see page ES-1).
(c) Warm up the A/F sensors (bank 1 sensor 1) by running
the engine at 2,500 rpm with the accelerator pedal
depressed more than 60 % for approximately 90
seconds.
(d) Read A/F sensor voltage output on the intelligent tester.
(e) Enter the following menus: ENHANCED OBD II /
SNAPSHOT / MANUAL SNAPSHOT / USER DATA.
(f) Select "AFS B1 S1/ENGINE SPD" and press button
"YES".
(g) Monitor the A/F sensor voltage carefully.
(h) Check the A/F sensor voltage output under the following
conditions:
(1) Put the engine in inspection mode and allow the
engine to idle for 30 seconds.
(2) Put the engine in inspection mode and running the
engine at 2,500 rpm with the accelerator pedal
depressed more than 60% (where engine RPM is
not suddenly changed).
(3) Deactivate the inspection mode and drive the
vehicle with shift position "B" range.
(4) Accelerate the vehicle to 70 km/h (44 mph) and
quickly release the accelerator pedal so that the
throttle valve is fully closed.
CAUTION:
• Strictly observe of posted speed limits, traffic laws,
and road conditions when performing these drive
patterns.
• Do not drive the vehicle without deactivating
inspection mode, otherwise damaging the transaxle
may result.
OK:
Condition (1) and (2)
Voltage changes in the vicinity of 3.3 V (between
approximately 3.1 to 3.5 V) as shown in the illustration.
Condition (4)
A/F sensor voltage increases to 3.8 V or more during
engine deceleration (when fuel cut) as shown in the
illustration.
ES
ES–358
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Malfunction Condition
Normal Condition
(4) Approximately 4,000 rpm
(2) 2,500 rpm
(2) 2,500 rpm
(1) Idle
(1) Idle
(1) Idle
(1) Idle
Engine
RPM
ES
(4) Approximately
4,000 rpm
Engine
RPM
"Condition (3)"
3.8 V or More
A/F Sensor
Voltage
A/F Sensor
Voltage
Fuel Cut
Fuel Cut
"Condition (1), (2)"
Change in the vicinity of approximately 3.3 V
When A/F sensor circuit is malfunctioning,
voltage output does not change
A072304E10
HINT:
• Whenever the output voltage of the A/F sensor remains at
approximately 3.3 V (see diagram Malfunction Condition)
under any condition as well as the above conditions, the A/
F sensor may have an open-circuit. (This will happen also
when the A/F sensor heater has an open-circuit.)
• Whenever the output voltage of the A/F sensor remains at
a certain value of approximately 3.8 V or more, or 2.8 V or
less (see diagram Malfunction Condition) under any
condition as well as the above conditions, the A/F sensor
may have a short-circuit.
• The ECM will stop fuel injection (fuel cut) during engine
deceleration. This will cause a LEAN condition and should
result in a momentary increase in A/F sensor voltage
output.
• The ECM must establish a closed throttle position learned
value to perform fuel cut. If the battery terminal was
reconnected, the vehicle must be driven over 10 mph to
allow the ECM to learn the closed throttle position.
• When the vehicle is driven:
The output voltage of the A/F sensor may be below 2.8 V
during fuel enrichment. For the vehicle, this translates to a
sudden increase in speed with the accelerator pedal fully
depressed when trying to overtake another vehicle. The A/
F sensor is functioning normally.
• The A/F sensor is a current output element, and therefore
the current is converted into voltage inside the ECM. If
measuring voltage at connectors of A/F sensor or ECM,
you will observe a constant voltage.
OK
Go to step 13
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–359
NG
3
INSPECT AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR (RESISTANCE OF A/F SENSOR HEATER)
(a) Disconnect the A5 A/F sensor connector.
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the A/F
sensor.
Standard resistance
Component Side
A/F Sensor Connector
HT
+B
A5
AF-
Resistance
1 (HT) - 2 (+B)
1.8 to 3.4 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
(c) Reconnect the A/F sensor connector.
AF+
Front View
Tester Connection
A085152E51
NG
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
OK
4
INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY (EFI M RELAY)
Integration Relay
Connector
IGCT
HORN
AM2
IG2
EFI
EFI M
Relay Detail
6
7
8
1
Specified Condition
3K-1 - 3I-8
10 kΩ or higher
3K-1 - 3I-8
Below 1 Ω
(Apply battery voltage to terminals
3I-6 and 3I-7)
NG
3I
3I
3I
3K
A082812E01
OK
Tester Connection
(c) Reinstall the integration relay.
3I
3I
3I
3K
8
7
6
1
(a) Remove the integration relay from the engine room relay
block.
(b) Inspect the EFI M relay.
Standard resistance
REPLACE INTEGRATION RELAY
ES
ES–360
5
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (A/F SENSOR - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the A5 A/F sensor connector.
Wire Harness Side
A/F Sensor Connector
A5
HT
+B
AF+
AFFront View
ES
A085153E07
(b) Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
(c) Check the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E5
HA1A
A1A-
A1A+
ECM Connector
A065745E71
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A5-3 (AF+) - E5-23 (A1A+)
Below 1 Ω
A5-4 (AF-) - E5-22 (A1A-)
Below 1 Ω
A5-1 (HT) - E5-7 (HA1A)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A5-3 (AF+) or E5-23 (A1A+) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
A5-4 (AF-) or E5-22 (A1A-) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
A5-1 (HT) or E5-7 (HA1A) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the A/F sensor connector.
(e) Reconnect the ECM connector.
Reference (Bank 1 Sensor 1 System Diagram)
From
Battery
EFI
EFI M
ECM
A/F Sensor
HA1A
Heater
A1A+
Sensor
A1A-
Duty
Control
MREL
B062793E19
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–361
OK
6
CHECK AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
(a) Check for vacuum leaks in the air induction system.
OK:
No leakage in the air induction system.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE AIR INDUCTION
SYSTEM
OK
ES
7
CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
OK:
Fuel pressure: 304 to 343 kPa (3.1 to 3.5 kgf/cm2, 44 to
50 psi)
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FUEL SYSTEM
OK
8
INSPECT FUEL INJECTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Check injector injection (high or low fuel injection
quantity or poor injection pattern).
OK:
Injection volume: 36 to 46 cm3 (2.1 to 2.8 cu in.) per
15 seconds.
NG
REPLACE FUEL INJECTOR ASSEMBLY
OK
9
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
GO
10
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
HINT:
Clear all DTCs prior to performing the confirmation driving
pattern.
GO
11
READ OUTPUT DTCS (SEE IF A/F SENSOR DTCS ARE OUTPUT AGAIN)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
ES–362
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(c) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs using the intelligent tester.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
No output
A
A/F sensor circuit DTCs
B
B
ES
Proceed to
REPLACE ECM AND PERFORM
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
A
12
CONFIRM IF VEHICLE HAS RUN OUT OF FUEL IN PAST
OK:
Vehicle has run out of fuel in past.
NO
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
YES
DTCS ARE CAUSED BY RUNNING OUT OF FUEL
13
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
HINT:
Clear all DTCs prior to performing the confirmation driving
pattern.
GO
14
READ OUTPUT DTCS (SEE IF A/F SENSOR DTCS ARE OUTPUT AGAIN)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs using the intelligent tester.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
A/F sensor circuit DTCs
A
No output
B
B
A
Go to step 18
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
15
ES–363
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
GO
16
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
HINT:
Clear all DTCs prior to performing the confirmation driving
pattern.
GO
17
ES
READ OUTPUT DTCS (SEE IF A/F SENSOR DTCS ARE OUTPUT AGAIN)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs using the intelligent tester.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
No output
A
A/F sensor circuit DTCs
B
B
REPLACE ECM AND PERFORM
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
A
18
CONFIRM IF VEHICLE HAS RUN OUT OF FUEL IN PAST
OK:
Vehicle has run out of fuel in past.
NO
YES
DTCS ARE CAUSED BY RUNNING OUT OF FUEL
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
ES–364
ES
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P2238
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Pumping Current Circuit
Low (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
DTC
P2239
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Pumping Current Circuit
High (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
DTC
P2252
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Reference Ground Circuit
Low (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
DTC
P2253
Oxygen (A/F) Sensor Reference Ground Circuit
High (Bank 1 Sensor 1)
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P2195 (see page ES-344).
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P2238
•
•
AF+ is 0.5 V or less for 5 seconds or more
A/F sensor admittance: Less than 0.022
1/Ω
•
•
•
•
•
•
Open or short in A/F sensor circuit
A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
EFI M relay
A/F sensor heater and relay circuit
ECM
P2239
AF+ is more than 4.5 V for 5 seconds or more
•
•
•
•
•
•
Open or short in A/F sensor circuit
A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
EFI M relay
A/F sensor heater and relay circuit
ECM
P2252
AF- is 0.5 V or less for 5 seconds or more
•
•
•
•
•
•
Open or short in A/F sensor circuit
A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
EFI M relay
A/F sensor heater and relay circuit
ECM
P2253
AF- is more than 4.5 V for 5 seconds or more
•
•
•
•
•
•
Open or short in A/F sensor circuit
A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
EFI M relay
A/F sensor heater and relay circuit
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The air fuel ratio (A/F) sensor has a characteristic that it varies its voltage output in proportion to the airfuel ratio. If impedance (alternating current resistance) or voltage output of the sensor extraordinarily
deviates from the standard range, the ECM determines to detect an open or short malfunction in the A/F
sensor circuit.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2238: A/F sensor pumping current circuit low
P2239: A/F sensor pumping current circuit high
P2252: A/F sensor reference ground circuit low
P2253: A/F sensor reference ground circuit high
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Required sensors/components (main)
Main:
A/F sensor
Related:
Engine speed sensor, vehicle speed sensor, engine coolant
temperature sensor
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
10 seconds
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of operation
None
ES–365
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
"General precondition" is defined as follows:
Battery voltage
10.5 V or more
Power switch
ON
Time after power switch from OFF to ON
5 seconds or more
"A/F sensor admittance precondition" is defined as follows:
Engine coolant temperature
Closed - loop fuel control or more
Engine
Running
Time after A/F sensor heating
20 seconds or more
P2238: A/F sensor pumping current circuit low
(AF+, AF- open)
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
None
Time while A/F sensor admittance precondition is met
10 seconds or more
P2238: A/F sensor pumping current circuit low
(AF+, AF- short)
General precondition
Met
P2238: A/F sensor pumping current circuit low
(AF+, GND short)
General precondition
Met
P2239: A/F sensor pumping current circuit high
General precondition
Met
P2252: A/F sensor reference ground circuit low
General precondition
Met
P2253: A/F sensor reference ground circuit high
General precondition
Met
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
P2238: A/F sensor pumping current circuit low
(AF+, AF- open)
A/F sensor admittance
Less than 0.022 1/Ω
P2238: A/F sensor pumping current circuit low
(AF+, AF- short)
A/F sensor admittance
0.1 V or less
P2238: A/F sensor pumping current circuit low
(AF+, GND short)
Difference between voltage of terminals AF+ and AF-
0.5 V or less
ES
ES–366
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
P2239: A/F sensor pumping current circuit high
(AF+, +B, VCC short)
AF+ terminal voltage (AF+ and +B, or AF+ and VCC short)
More than 4.5 V
P2252: A/F sensor reference ground circuit low
AF- terminal voltage (AF- and GND short)
0.5 V or less
P2253: A/F sensor reference ground circuit high
AF- terminal voltage (AF- and +B, or AF- and VCC short)
More than 4.5 V
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P2195 (see page ES-347).
ES
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Although the each DTC title says "oxygen sensor", these DTCs are related to the A/F sensor.
• Malfunctioning areas can be found by performing the ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL operation. The
A/F CONTROL operation can determine if the A/F sensor, heated oxygen sensor or other potential
trouble area are malfunctioning or not.
(a) Perform the ACTIVE TEST A/F CONTROL operation.
HINT:
The A/F CONTROL operation lowers the injection volume 12.5% or increases the injection volume 25%.
(1) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(3) Put the engine in inspection mode (see page ES-1).
(4) Warm up the engine by running the engine at 2,500 rpm, depressing the accelerator pedal more than
60% for approximately 90 seconds.
(5) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL.
(6) Perform the A/F CONTROL operation with the engine in an idle condition (press the right or left
button).
Result:
A/F sensor reacts in accordance with increase and decrease of injection volume:
+25% → rich output: Less than 3.0 V
-12.5% → lean output: More than 3.35 V
Heated oxygen sensor reacts in accordance with increase and decrease of injection volume:
+25% → rich output: More than 0.55 V
-12.5% → lean output: Less than 0.4 V
NOTICE:
The A/F sensor output has a few seconds of delay and the heated oxygen sensor output has about
20 seconds of delay at maximum.
Case
A/F Sensor (Sensor 1) Output Voltage
HO2 Sensor (Sensor 2) Output Voltage
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
Output Voltage
More than 0.55 V
Less than 0.4 V
Main Suspected
Trouble Area
-
1
ES–367
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Case
2
A/F Sensor (Sensor 1) Output Voltage
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output
Voltage
Almost
no
reaction
Main Suspected
Trouble Area
HO2 Sensor (Sensor 2) Output Voltage
Output Voltage
More than 0.55 V
Less than 0.4 V
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
3
4
•
•
•
A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
A/F sensor circuit
•
•
•
HO2 sensor
HO2 sensor heater
HO2 sensor circuit
•
•
•
Fuel Injector
Fuel pressure
Gas leakage from
exhaust system (Airfuel ratio extremely
or lean rich)
The following A/F CONTROL procedure enables the technician to check and graph the voltage output of
both A/F sensor and heated oxygen sensor.
To display the graph, enter ACTIVE TEST/ A/F CONTROL/USER DATA, select "AFS B1S1 and O2S
B1S2" by pressing the "YES" button followed by the "ENTER" button and then the "F4" button.
HINT:
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine condition
when malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the
vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or
rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
• A high A/F sensor voltage could be caused by a RICH air-fuel mixture. Check the conditions that would
cause the engine to run with the RICH air-fuel mixture.
• A low A/F sensor voltage could be caused by a LEAN air-fuel mixture. Check the conditions that would
cause the engine to run with the LEAN air-fuel mixture.
1
INSPECT AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR (RESISTANCE OF A/F SENSOR HEATER)
(a) Disconnect the A5 A/F sensor connector.
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the A/F
sensor.
Standard resistance
Component Side
A/F Sensor Connector
HT
+B
A5
AF-
Front View
Resistance
1 (HT) - 2 (+B)
1.8 to 3.4 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
(c) Reconnect the A/F sensor connector.
AF+
A085152E51
OK
Tester Connection
NG
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
ES
ES–368
2
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY (EFI M RELAY)
Integration Relay
Connector
IGCT
ES
HORN
AM2
IG2
EFI
EFI M
Relay Detail
8
7
6
1
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3K-1 - 3I-8
10 kΩ or higher
3K-1 - 3I-8
Below 1 Ω
(Apply battery voltage to terminals
3I-6 and 3I-7)
(c) Reinstall the integration relay.
3I
3I
3I
3K
6
7
8
1
(a) Remove the integration relay from the engine room relay
block.
(b) Inspect the EFI M relay.
Standard resistance
NG
REPLACE INTEGRATION RELAY
3I
3I
3I
3K
A082812E01
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (A/F SENSOR - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the A5 A/F sensor connector.
Wire Harness Side
A/F Sensor Connector
A5
HT
+B
AF+
AFFront View
A085153E07
(b) Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
(c) Check the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E5
HA1A
A1A+
A1AECM Connector
A065745E71
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A5-3 (AF+) - E5-23 (A1A+)
Below 1 Ω
A5-4 (AF-) - E5-22 (A1A-)
Below 1 Ω
A5-1 (HT) - E5-7 (HA1A)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A5-3 (AF+) or E5-23 (A1A+) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
ES–369
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A5-4 (AF-) or E5-22 (A1A-) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
A5-1 (HT) or E5-7 (HA1A) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the A/F sensor connector.
(e) Reconnect the ECM connector.
Reference (Bank 1 Sensor 1 System Diagram)
From
Battery
EFI
EFI M
ECM
A/F Sensor
HA1A
ES
Heater
A1A+
Sensor
A1A-
Duty
Control
MREL
B062793E19
NG
OK
REPLACE ECM
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
ES–370
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P2420
Evaporative Emission Pressure Switching
Valve Stuck OFF
DTC SUMMARY
DTC No.
P2420
ES
Monitoring Items
Vent valve stuck
open (vent)
Malfunction
Detection
Conditions
The following
condition is met
during key-off EVAP
monitor:
• EVAP pressure
change when
vent valve is
closed (ON) less
than 0.3 kPa-g
(2.25 mmHg-g)
Trouble Areas
•
•
•
Canister pump
module
(reference orifice,
leak detection
pump, vent valve)
Connector/wire
harness (canister
pump module ECM)
ECM
Detection Timing
Power switch OFF
Detection Logic
2 trip
DESCRIPTION
NOTICE:
In this vehicle's EVAP system, turning ON the vent valve does not seal off the EVAP system. To
check for leaks in the EVAP system, disconnect the air inlet vent hose and apply pressure from
the atmosphere side of the canister.
While the engine is running, if a predetermined condition (closed loop, etc.) is met, the purge VSV is
opened by the ECM and stored fuel vapors in the canister are purged to the intake manifold. The ECM
changes the duty cycle ratio of the purge VSV to control purge flow volume.
The purge flow volume is also determined by the intake manifold pressure. Atmospheric pressure is
allowed into the canister through the vent valve to ensure that the purge flow is maintained when the
negative pressure (vacuum) is applied to the canister.
Key-off monitor
This monitor checks for Evaporative Emission (EVAP) system leaks and canister pump module
malfunctions. The monitor starts 5 hours* after the power switch is turned OFF. More than 5 hours are
required to allow the fuel to cool down to stabilize the Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP), thus making the EVAP
system monitor more accurate.
The leak detection pump creates negative pressure (vacuum) in the EVAP system and the pressure is
measured. Finally, the ECM monitors for leaks from the EVAP system and malfunctions in both the
canister pump module and purge VSV, based on the EVAP pressure.
HINT:
*: If the engine coolant temperature is not below 35°C (95°F) 5 hours after the power switch is turned OFF,
the monitor check starts 2 hours later. If it is still not below 35°C (95°F) 7 hours after the power switch is
turned OFF, the monitor check starts 2.5 hours later.
ES–371
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Location
EVAP Hose (From Canister)
Purge Line
EVAP Hose (To Intake Manifold)
Purge VSV
ES
Pump Module
Trap Canister
- Leak Detection Pump
- Canister Pressure Sensor
- Vent Valve
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor
Pressure Switching Valve
Canister Filter
Canister
Fuel Tank
Air Inlet Port
Fuel Cap
A131350E01
ES–372
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Diagram
Intake Manifold
Purge VSV
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor
ES
Fuel Cap
Pressure Switching Valve
Fresh Air Line
Canister
Fuel Pump Chamber
Canister Filter
Bladder Tank
Trap Canister with Pump Module
Outer Tank
Roll Over Valve
A130305E01
Pump Module
: Air Flow
Vent Valve (ON)
From
Canister
Filter
Trap Canister
Vent Valve (OFF)
Reference Orifice
Pressure Sensor
Leak Detection Pump (OFF)
Leak Detection Pump (ON)
A131438E01
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–373
Canister Pressure Sensor Specification
Malfunction Area
Output Voltage
4.900 V
4.150 V
Usable Range
ES
1.425 V
Malfunction Area
0.450 V
60 kPa
110 kPa
(450 mmHg) (825 mmHg)
Pressure
HINT:
Standard atmospheric pressure is 101.3 kPa (760mmHg)
A115543E09
Components
Operations
Canister, Trap canister
Contains activated charcoal to absorb EVAP generated in fuel tank.
Cut-off valve
Located in fuel tank. Valve floats and closes when fuel tank 100% full.
Purge Vacuum Switching Valve (VSV)
Opens or closes line between canister and intake manifold. ECM uses
purge VSV to control EVAP purge flow. In order to discharge EVAP
absorbed by canister to intake manifold, ECM opens purge VSV.
EVAP discharge volume to intake manifold controlled by purge VSV
duty cycle ratio (current-carrying time) (open: ON; closed: OFF).
Roll-over valve
Located in fuel tank. Valve closes by its own weight when vehicle
overturns to prevent fuel from spilling out.
Soak timer
Built into ECM. To ensure accurate EVAP monitor, measures 5 hours
(+-15 min) after power switch OFF. This allows fuel to cool down,
stabilizing Fuel Tank Pressure (FTP). When approximately 5 hours
elapsed, ECM activates.
Pressure switching valve
The pressure switching valve located on the canister is used to detect
leakage from the bladder tank into the fuel tank. The valve opens
during the bladder tank leak check. Then, the fuel tank's fuel vapor
flows to the intake manifold without passing the canister.
Pump module
Consists of (a) to (d) below. Pump module cannot be disassembled.
(a) Vent valve
Vents and closes EVAP system. When ECM turns valve ON, EVAP
system closed. When ECM turns valve OFF, EVAP system vented.
Negative pressure (vacuum) created in EVAP system to check for
EVAP leaks by closing purge VSV, turning vent valve ON (closed) and
operating leak detection pump (refer to fig. 1).
(b) Canister pressure sensor
Indicates pressure as voltage. ECM supplies regulated 5 V to canister
pressure sensor, and uses feedback from sensor to monitor EVAP
system pressure (refer to fig. 2).
(c) Leak detection pump
Creates negative pressure (vacuum) in EVAP system for leak check.
ES–374
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Components
Operations
Has opening with 0.02 inch diameter. Vacuum produced through
orifice by closing purge VSV, turning vent valve OFF and operating
leak detection pump to monitor 0.02 inch leak criterion. 0.02 inch leak
criterion indicates small leak of EVAP.
(d) Reference orifice
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
ES
5 hours* after the power switch is turned OFF, the leak detection pump creates negative pressure
(vacuum) in the EVAP system. The ECM monitors for leaks and actuator malfunctions based on the EVAP
pressure.
HINT:
*: If the engine coolant temperature is not below 35°C (95°F) 5 hours after the power switch is turned OFF,
the monitor check starts 2 hours later. If it is still not below 35°C (95°F) 7 hours after the power switch is
turned OFF, the monitor check starts 2.5 hours later.
Sequence
Descriptions
Duration
ECM activation
Activated by soak timer 5, 7 or 9.5
hours after power switch OFF.
-
Atmospheric pressure
measurement
Vent valve turned OFF (vent) and
EVAP system pressure measured
by ECM in order to register
atmospheric pressure.
If pressure in EVAP system not
between 70 kPa and 110 kPa
(525 mmHg and 825 mmHg),
ECM cancels EVAP system
monitor.
10 seconds
First 0.02 inch leak criterion
measurement
In order to determine 0.02 inch
leak criterion, leak detection
pump creates negative pressure
(vacuum) through reference
orifice and then ECM checks if
leak detection pump and vent
valve operate normally.
60 seconds
EVAP system pressure
measurement
Vent valve turned ON (closed) to
shut EVAP system.
Negative pressure (vacuum)
created in EVAP system, and
EVAP system pressure then
measured.
Write down measured value as it
will be used in leak check.
If EVAP pressure does not
stabilize within 900 seconds,
ECM cancels EVAP system
monitor.
900 seconds*
Purge VSV monitor
Purge VSV opened and then
EVAP system pressure measured
by ECM.
Large increase indicates normal.
10 seconds
E
Second 0.02 inch leak criterion
measurement
After second 0.02 inch leak
criterion measurement, leak
check performed by comparing
first and second 0.02 inch leak
criterion.
If stabilized system pressure
higher than second 0.02 inch leak
criterion, ECM determines that
EVAP system leaking.
60 seconds
-
Final check
Atmospheric pressure measured
and then monitoring result
recorded by ECM.
-
-
A
B
C
D
Operations
*: If only a small amount of fuel is in the fuel tank, it takes longer for the EVAP pressure to stabilize.
ES–375
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Operation A: Atmospheric Pressure Measurement
Purge VSV: OFF
Canister
Fuel Tank
Vent Valve: OFF (vent)
Reference
Orifice
Canister
Pressure
Sensor
Operation B, E: 0.02 Inch Leak
Criterion Measurement
OFF
OFF (vent)
Canister Pump Module
Canister Filter
ES
ON
Leak Detection Pump: OFF
Operation C: EVAP System Pressure Measurement
OFF
ON
ON (closed)
Atmospheric
Pressure
Negative
Pressure
Operation D: Purge VSV Monitor
ON
ON (closed)
ON
A122912E01
ES–376
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
1. P2420: Vent valve stuck open (vent)
In operation C, the vent valve turns ON (closes) and the EVAP system pressure is then measured by
the ECM using the canister pressure sensor to conduct an EVAP leak check. If pressure does not drop
when the vent valve is open, the ECM interprets this as the vent valve being stuck open. The ECM
illuminates the MIL and sets the DTC.
EVAP Pressure when Vent Valve Stuck OFF:
ON
Purge VSV
OFF: Closed
ON: Closed
ON
Vent Valve
ES
ON: Open
OFF: Vent
Leak Detection
Pump
ON
EVAP Pressure
Positive
Negative
OK
0.02 Inch
Leak Criterion
Malfunction
Sequence
Time (Second)
A
B
C
D
E
10
60
Within 900
10
60
A106067E03
MONITOR STRATEGY
Required Sensors/Components
Purge VSV and canister pump module
Frequency of Operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
Maximum 15 seconds
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever these DTCs are not present
P0011, P0012, P0021, P0022 (VVT system-Advance, Retard)
P0100, P0101, P0102, P0103 (MAF sensor)
P0110, P0112, P0113 (IAT sensor)
P0115, P0116, P0117, P0118 (ECT sensor)
P0120, P0122, P0123, P0220, P0222, P0223, P2135,(TP sensor)
P0125 (Insufficient ECT for closed loop)
P0171, P0172, P0174, P0175 (Fuel system)
P0300, P0301, P0302, P0303, P0304 (Misfire)
P0335 (CKP sensor)
P0340, P0341 (CMP sensor)
P0351, P0352, P0353, P0354 (Igniter)
P0450, P0452, P0453 (EVAP press sensor)
P0500 (VSS)
Atmospheric pressure
70 to 110 kPa (525 to 825 mmHg)
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Battery voltage
10.5 V or higher
Vehicle speed
Less than 4 km/h (2.5 mph)
Power switch
OFF
Time after key off
5, 7 or 9.5 hours
Purge VSV
Not operated by scan tool
Vent valve
Not operated by scan tool
Leak detection pump
Not operated by scan tool
Both of the following conditions 1 and 2 are met before key off
-
1. Duration that vehicle has been driven
5 minutes or more
2. EVAP purge operation
Performed
ECT
4.4 to 35°C (40 to 95°F)
IAT
4.4 to 35°C (40 to 95°F)
1. Key-off monitor sequence 1 to 8
1. Atmospheric pressure measurement
Next sequence is run if the following condition is met
-
Atmospheric pressure change
Within 0.3 kPa (2.25 mmHg) in 1 second
2. First reference pressure measurement
Next sequence is run if the following conditions are met
-
EVAP pressure just after reference pressure measurement start
1 kPa ( 7.5 mmHg) or lower
Reference pressure
-4.85 to -1.05 kPa (726 to 754 mmHg)
Reference pressure
Saturated within 60 seconds
3. Vent valve stuck closed check
Next sequence is run if the following condition is met
-
EVAP pressure change after vent valve is ON
0.3 kPa (2.25 mmHg) or more
4. Vacuum introduction
Next sequence is run if the following condition is met
-
EVAP pressure
Saturated within 900 seconds
5. Purge VSV stuck closed check
Next sequence is run if the following condition is met
-
EVAP pressure change after purge valve is open
0.3 kPa (2.25 mmHg) or more
6. Second reference pressure measurement
Next sequence is run if the following conditions are met
-
EVAP pressure just after reference pressure measurement
1 kPa (7.5 mmHg) or lower
Reference pressure
-4.85 to -1.05 kPa (726 to 754 mmHg)
Reference pressure
Saturated within 60 seconds
Reference pressure difference between first and second
Less than 0.7 kPa (5.25 mmHg)
7. Leak check
Next sequence is run if the following condition is met
-
EVAP pressure when vacuum introduction is complete
Lower than second reference pressure
8. Atmospheric pressure measurement
EVAP monitor is complete if the following condition is met
-
Atmospheric pressure difference between sequence 1 and 8
Within 0.3 kPa (2.25 mmHg)
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
1. P2420: Vent valve stuck open (vent)
EVAP pressure change after EVAP canister vent valve is ON
Less than 0.3 kPa (2.25 mmHg)
ES–377
ES
ES–378
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to CHECKING MONITOR STATUS (see page ES-15).
WIRING DIAGRAM
Canister Pump Module
ES
ECM
Leak Detection Pump
MGND
MTRB
MPMP
5V
VCC
Canister
Pressure
Sensor
VC
VOUT
PPMP
E2
SGND
Vent Valve
VLVB
VPMP
VGND
Purge VSV
EVP1
MAIN
P/I
EFI
EFI M
MREL
A127933E01
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–379
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
The intelligent tester is required to conduct the following diagnostic troubleshooting procedure.
HINT:
• Using the intelligent tester monitor results enable the EVAP system to be confirmed.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine conditions
when malfunctions are detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the
vehicle was moving or stationary, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or
rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
CONFIRM DTC
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
Turn the power switch OFF and wait for 10 seconds.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the power switch OFF and wait for 10 seconds.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(g) Check if DTC P0446 is output.
NO
Go to step 5
YES
2
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK
(a) Note the freeze frame data and DTCs.
(b) Clear DTCs.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK / EVAP SYS CHECK / AUTO
OPERATION.
(d) After the system check is finished, check for pending
DTCs.
OK:
No DTC is present.
NG
Go to step 6
OK
3
CHECK OPERATION FOR PRESSURE SWITCHING VALVE
(a) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / TANK BYPASS VSV.
(b) Touch the pressure switching valve (TANK BYPASS
VSV) to feel the operating vibration.
OK:
The pressure switching valve is operated by the
ACTIVE TEST.
NG
Go to step 18
ES
ES–380
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
OK
4
CHECK PRESSURE SWITCHING VALVE
Air
ES
Turn the power switch OFF.
Remove the pressure switching valve (see page EC-31).
Reconnect the pressure switching valve connector.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / TANK BYPASS VSV.
(e) Check the airflow for the pressure switching valve.
OK:
The pressure switching valve operates normally.
Air
E
F
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
E
F
VSV is ON
VSV is OFF
A087973E01
5
NG
Go to step 19
OK
Go to step 33
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK
(a) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK / EVAP SYS CHECK / AUTO
OPERATION.
(b) After the system check is finished, check for pending
DTCs.
OK:
DTCs are present.
NG
CHECK INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
OK
6
CHECK DTC
(a) Check the DTCs that were present at the EVAP system
check.
OK:
P043E, P043F, P2401, P2402 and P2419 are present.
NG
Go to step 10
OK
7
CHECK VENT VALVE CLOSE STUCK
(a) Allow the engine to idle.
(b) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / EVAP VSV.
(c) Turn the EVAP VSV ON (purge VSV open) and check
the VAPOR PRESS (EVAP pressure) for 10 seconds.
OK:
EVAP pressure is higher than 755 mmHg.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
NG
ES–381
Go to step 20
OK
8
CHECK LEAK DETECTION PUMP OPERATION
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / VACUUM PUMP.
(d) Touch the pump module to feel the operating vibration.
OK:
The leak detection pump is operated by the
ACTIVE TEST.
NG
Go to step 21
OK
9
CHECK TRAP CANISTER
(a) Disconnect the vent hose from the pump module.
(b) Check that no moisture is in the pump module or the
vent hose.
OK:
No moisture.
OK
Go to step 22
NG
Go to step 23
A135512
10
CHECK DTC
(a) Check the DTCs that were present at the EVAP system
check.
OK:
P0441, P0455 and/or P0456 are present.
NG
Go to step 16
OK
11
CHECK INSTALLATION FOR FUEL CAP
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Remove the fuel cap.
Reinstall the fuel cap.
Clear DTCs.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK / EVAP SYS CHECK / AUTO
OPERATION.
ES
ES–382
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(e) After the system check is finished, check for pending
DTCs.
HINT:
If no DTC is present, this indicates that the fuel cap is
loosened.
OK:
No DTC is present.
OK
REPAIR COMPLETED
NG
ES
12
LOCATE LEAK POINT
(a) Disconnect the vent hose (fresh air line) as shown in the
illustration.
Canister Filter
Vent Hose to Canister
Vent Hose
Adapter
EVAP Tester
A131407E01
(b) Connect the pressure gauge and air pump as shown in
the illustration.
(c) Pressurize the EVAP system until 24 to 28 mmHg.
(d) Locate the leak point.
HINT:
If the EVAP system has leakage, a whistling sound may
be heard.
OK:
The leak point is found.
OK
Go to step 24
NG
13
CHECK FUEL CAP
Check that the fuel cap meets OEM specifications.
HINT:
If an EVAP tester is available, perform the fuel cap test
according to the tester's instructions.
OK:
Fuel cap meets OEM specifications.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
NG
ES–383
Go to step 25
OK
14
CHECK OPERATION FOR PURGE VSV
(a) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / EVAP VSV.
(b) Touch the purge VSV to feel the operating vibration.
OK:
The purge VSV (EVAP VSV) is operated by the
ACTIVE TEST.
NG
Go to step 26
OK
15
CHECK INTAKE MANIFOLD PRESSURE
(a) Disconnect the purge VSV hose that is connected to the
throttle body.
(b) Allow the engine to idle.
(c) Check that the hose has suction using your finger.
OK:
The hose has suction.
Purge VSV
Hose (to Intake Manifold)
A130450E01
16
NG
Go to step 27
OK
Go to step 28
CHECK DTC
(a) Check the DTCs that were present at the EVAP system
check.
OK:
P0451 is not present.
NG
Go to step 9
OK
17
CHECK OPERATION FOR VENT VALVE
(a) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / VENT VALVE.
(b) Touch the pump module to feel the operating vibration.
OK:
The vent valve is operated by the ACTIVE TEST.
OK
Go to step 9
NG
Go to step 29
ES
ES–384
18
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (PRESSURE SWITCHING VALVE - ECM AND EFI M
RELAY)
Wire Harness Side
Pressure Switching Valve Connector
(a) Check the harness and the connectors between the
pressure switching valve and the ECM.
(1) Disconnect the V8 pressure switching valve
connector.
V8
ES
Front View
A072890E04
(2) Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
(3) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E7
TBP
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V8-1 (Pressure switching valve) - E718 (TBP)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
ECM Connector
A065744E70
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V8-1 (Pressure switching valve) or
E7-18 (TBP) - Body ground
10 kΩ higher
(4) Reconnect the pressure switching valve connector.
(5) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(b) Check the harness and the connectors between the
pressure switching valve and the EFI M relay.
(1) Disconnect the V8 pressure switching valve
connector.
(2) Remove the integration relay from the engine room
relay block.
(3) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connector.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
8 3I
Engine Room Relay Block
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V8-2 (Pressure switching valve) - 3I-8
(EFI M relay)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
A082810E01
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V8-2 (Pressure switching valve) or 3I8 (EFI M relay) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(4) Reconnect the pressure switching valve connector.
(5) Reinstall the integration relay.
NG
Go to step 30
OK
Go to step 31
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
19
ES–385
REPLACE PRESSURE SWITCHING VALVE
Replace the pressure switching valve (see page EC-31).
NEXT
20
Go to step 34
CHECK FOR VENT HOSE CLOG
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the vent hose (fresh air line) as shown in the
illustration.
(c) Allow the engine to idle.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / EVAP VSV.
(e) Turn the purge VSV (EVAP VSV) ON and check the
EVAP pressure (VAPOR PRESS) for 10 seconds.
OK:
EVAP pressure is higher than 755 mmHg.
A135512
21
NG
Go to step 22
OK
Go to step 32
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (LEAK DETECTION PUMP - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the V7 canister connector
Wire Harness Side
V7
MTRB
Canister
Connector
MGND
Front View
A085258E49
(b) Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E7
MPMP
ECM Connector
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V7-1 (MTRB) - E7-13 (MPMP)
Below 1 Ω
V7-6 (MGND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
A065744E71
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V7-1 (MTRB) or E7-13 (MPMP) - Body
ground
10 kΩ higher
(d) Reconnect the canister connector.
(e) Reconnect the ECM connector.
ES
ES–386
22
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
NG
Go to step 30
OK
Go to step 31
REPLACE TRAP CANISTER WITH PUMP MODULE
Replace the trap canister with pump module (see page EC17).
NEXT
ES
23
Go to step 34
CHECK FOR VENT HOSE DAMAGE
Check for hose damage as shown in the illustration. If
necessary, replace the vent hose.
Vent Hose
Inspection Area*
Canister Filter
Vent Hose
Air Inlet Port
*: Check for disconnection and/or crack
A130304E01
NEXT
Go to step 22
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
24
25
26
ES–387
REPAIR OR REPLACE LEAK POINT
NEXT
Go to step 34
NEXT
Go to step 34
REPLACE FUEL CAP
ES
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (PURGE VSV - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the V1 purge VSV connector.
Wire Harness Side
Purge VSV
Connector
V1
Front View
A052933E24
(b) Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
(c) Check the harness and the connectors between the
ECM and the purge VSV connectors.
(1) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connector.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E5
ECM Connector
EVP1
A065745E73
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V1-1 - E5-14 (EVP1)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V1-1 or E5-14 (EVP1) - Body ground
10 kΩ higher
(d) Remove the integration relay from the engine room relay
block.
(e) Check the harness and connectors between the purge
VSV connector and the EFI M relay.
(1) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
8 3I
Engine Room Relay Block
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V1-2 - 3I-8 (EFI M relay)
Below 1 Ω
A082810E01
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V1-2 or 3I-8 (EFI M relay) - Body
ground
10 kΩ higher
(f) Reconnect the purge VSV connector.
(g) Reconnect the ECM connector.
ES–388
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(h) Reinstall the integration relay.
27
NG
Go to step 30
OK
Go to step 31
REPLACE HOSE (PURGE VSV - THROTTLE BODY)
NEXT
ES
28
Go to step 34
REPLACE PURGE VSV
Replace the purge VSV (see page EC-23).
NEXT
29
Go to step 34
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (VENT VALVE - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the V7 canister connector.
Wire Harness Side
VLVB
V7
Canister
Connector
Front View
VGND
A085258E50
(b) Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
(c) Check the harness and the connectors between the
ECM and the canister connectors.
(1) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connector.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E7
VPMP
ECM Connector
A065744E72
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V7-8 (VGND) - E7-26 (VPMP)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V7-8 (VGND) or E7-26 (VPMP) - Body
ground
10 kΩ higher
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–389
(d) Remove the integration relay from the engine room relay
block.
(e) Check the harness and connectors between the canister
connector and the EFI M relay.
(1) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
8 3I
Engine Room Relay Block
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V7-9 (VLVB) - 3I-8 (EFI M relay)
Below 1 Ω
A082810E01
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V7-9 (VLVB) or 3I-8 (EFI M relay) Body ground
10 kΩ higher
(f) Reconnect the canister connector.
(g) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(h) Reinstall the integration relay.
30
NG
Go to step 30
OK
Go to step 31
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
NEXT
31
Go to step 34
REPLACE ECM
Replace the ECM (see page ES-469).
NEXT
32
CHECK AND REPLACE VENT HOSE OR CANISTER FILTER
NEXT
33
Go to step 34
Go to step 34
REPLACE HOSE (PRESSURE SWITCHING VALVE AND FUEL TANK)
NEXT
34
PERFORM EVAP SYSTEM CHECK
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / SYSTEM CHECK / EVAP SYS CHECK / AUTO
OPERATION.
(c) After the system check is finished, check for pending
DTCs.
ES
ES–390
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
OK:
No DTC is present.
NG
Go to step 6
OK
35
PERFORM EVAP MONITOR DRIVE PATTERN
(a) Check that the following conditions are met:
• Fuel level is 1/8 to 7/8.
• Engine coolant temperature (ECT) is 4.4 to 35°C (40
to 95°F).
• Intake air temperature (IAT) is 4.4 to 35°C (40 to
95°F).
• Difference of ECT and IAT is less than 7°C (13°F).
(b) Enter the check mode. Enter the following menus:
DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / CHECK MODE.
(c) Allow the engine to idle until the ECT is 75°C (167°F).
(d) Drive the vehicle at 50 km/h (30 mph) or faster and
maintain that speed for 60 seconds or more.
(e) Stop the vehicle. Do not turn the power switch OFF.
(f) Check that the EVAP monitor status is complete. Enter
the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II /
MONITOR STATUS.
(g) If the EVAP monitor is incomplete, drive the vehicle at 50
km/h (30 mph) or faster and maintain that speed for 120
seconds or more. After that, recheck the EVAP monitor
status.
(h) Check for pending DTCs.
OK:
No DTC is present.
ES
NG
OK
REPAIR COMPLETED
Go to step 2
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P2601
ES–391
Coolant Pump Control Circuit Range / Performance
DESCRIPTION
The coolant heat storage system uses an electric pump to supply hot coolant stored in the CHS tank into
the cylinder head of the engine, in order to optimize engine starting combustion and reduce the amount of
unburned gas that is discharged while the engine is started. Before the engine starts, the ECM operates
the electric water pump to direct the hot coolant in the CHS tank into the engine, in order to heat the
cylinder head (this process is called "preheat mode"). This system consists of the CHS tank, CHS water
pump, CHS tank outlet temperature sensor, water valve, and a soak timer that is built in the ECM.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P2601
Following conditions are successively met:
• Difference in CHS tank outlet water
temperature and engine coolant
temperatures before and after starting
preheating: within 2°C (3.6°F)
• Change in CHS tank outlet water
temperature during soaking: Below 1°C
(1.8°F) of its temperature before CHS
water pump is ON
•
•
•
•
CHS water pump
CHS water pump relay
Open or short in CHS water pump circuit
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM detects malfunction in the coolant heat storage (CHS) system with the CHS tank coolant
temperature, the position of the water valve, the running condition of the engine and the operating
condition of the soak timer.
The soak timer built in the ECM prompts the ECM to actuate the water pump 5 hours after the HV system
has been turned OFF by using the power switch. The ECM then checks the HV main system based on
variations in the CHS tank outlet temperature (soak mode).
In order to ensure the reliable malfunction detection, the ECM detects the CHS water pump malfunction
DTC in two ways. Thus, when the following two detection conditions are consecutively met, the ECM
determines that there is malfunction in the water pump circuit and sets the DTC.
(1) Difference in the CHS tank outlet temperature and the engine coolant temperature before and after
starting preheating at engine start (system start) is below 2°C (3.6°F).
(2) Variation in the CHS tank outlet temperature during soak mode is within 1°C (1.8°F) of its temperature
before the CHS water pump was ON.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2601: Coolant pump control circuit range/performance
Required sensors/components
Coolant heat storage tank outlet temperature sensor
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
10 seconds
MIL operation
1 driving cycle
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
None
Coolant heat storage system malfunction
Not detected
CHS water pump operation time
3 seconds or more
Variation in CHS tank outlet temperature and engine coolant
temperature before and after preheating
2°C (3.6°F) or less
Storage coolant temperature
More than 65°C (149°F)
ES
ES–392
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Difference in CHS tank outlet coolant temperature before and after
CHS water pump ON
Less than 1°C (1.8°F)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P1120 (see page ES-301).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
ES
CAUTION:
Be careful when replacing any part in the CHS system or changing the coolant because the
coolant in the CHS tank is hot even if the engine and the radiator are cold.
NOTICE:
If air bleeding is not performed completely, this DTC may be detected after changing the coolant.
HINT:
• CHS stands for Coolant Heat Storage.
• Although the DTC title says "Coolant Pump", this DTC is related to the CHS water pump.
• The detection of this DTC indicates a malfunction in both the CHS water pump and the CHS W/P relay.
Therefore, make sure to also check the relay when this DTC is output.
• To check the coolant heat storage (CHS) system, the ECM may cause the water pump of the CHS
system to operate 5 hours after the power switch has been turned OFF.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine condition
when malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the
vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or
rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
CHECK OTHER DTC OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P2601)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P2601
A
P2601 and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides P2601 are output, perform
troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
A
2
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (OPERATE WATER PUMP)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Turn the tester ON.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–393
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / WATER PUMP.
(e) Check that the CHS W/P relay operates and the
operating sounds of the water pump occurs.
Result
Tester operation
Specified Condition
WATER PUMP ON
CHS W/P relay and water pump
operates
NG
Go to step 5
OK
3
INSPECT TEMPERATURE SENSOR (CHS TANK OUTLET TEMPERATURE SENSOR)
(a) Remove the coolant heat storage (CHS) tank outlet
temperature sensor.
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals.
Standard resistance
Ohmmeter
Resistance
kΩ
Acceptable
Temperature °C (°F)
A081700E08
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1-2
2 to 3 kΩ at 20°C (68°F)
1-2
0.2 to 0.4 kΩ at 80°C (176°F)
NOTICE:
In case of checking the CHS tank outlet temperature
sensor in the water, be careful not to allow water to
contact the terminals. After checking, dry the sensor.
HINT:
Alternate procedure: Connect an ohmmeter to the
installed CHS tank outlet temperature sensor and read
the resistance. Use an infrared thermometer to measure
the CHS tank outlet temperature in the immediate vicinity
of the sensor. Compare these values to the resistance/
temperature graph. Change the engine temperature
(warm up or allow to cool down) and repeat the test.
(c) Reinstall the coolant heat storage tank outlet
temperature sensor.
NG
OK
REPLACE TEMPERATURE SENSOR
ES
ES–394
4
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (ECM - CHS TANK OUTLET TEMPERATURE
SENSOR)
Wire Harness Side
CHS Tank Outlet Temperature Sensor
Connector
(a) Check the harness and the connectors between the CHS
tank outlet temperature sensor connector and the ECM
connector.
(1) Disconnect the C19 CHS tank outlet temperature
sensor connector.
C19
Front View
ES
A082813E03
E4
(2) Disconnect the E4 and E7 ECM connectors.
(3) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open):
E7
E2
THW2
ECM Connector
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
C19-2 (CHS tank outlet temperature
sensor) - E7-33 (THW2)
Below 1 Ω
C19-1 (CHS tank outlet temperature
sensor) - E4-28 (E2)
Below 1 Ω
A082814E01
Standard resistance (Check for short):
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
C19-2 (CHS tank outlet temperature
sensor) or E7-33 (THW2) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(4) Reconnect the CHS tank outlet temperature sensor
connector.
(5) Reconnect the ECM connectors.
NG
OK
REPLACE ECM
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
5
ES–395
INSPECT COOLANT HEAT STORAGE WATER PUMP RELAY (CHS WATER PUMP RELAY)
(a) Remove the CHS W/P relay from the engine room No. 2
relay block.
(b) Inspect the CHS W/P relay.
Standard resistance
B016200E02
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
Below 1 Ω
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
(Apply battery voltage to terminals 1
and 2)
(c) Reinstall the CHS W/P relay.
NG
REPLACE COOLANT HEAT STORAGE
WATER PUMP RELAY
OK
6
INSPECT WATER W/MOTOR & BRACKET PUMP ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the C20 CHS water pump connector.
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the
water pump.
Standard resistance
Component Side
CHS Water Pump Connector
C20
(+)
(-)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1-2
0.3 to 100 Ω
(c) Reconnect the CHS water pump connector.
Front View
A075926E01
NG
REPLACE WATER W/MOTOR & BRACKET
PUMP ASSEMBLY
OK
7
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (CHS W/P RELAY - WATER PUMP AND ECM,
WATER PUMP - GROUND)
(a) Check the harness and the connectors between the CHS
water pump connector and the ECM connector.
(1) Remove the CHS W/P relay from the engine room
No. 2 relay block.
Wire Harness Side
CHS Water Pump Connector
C20
Front View
A052933E20
ES
ES–396
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(2) Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
(3) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E7
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E7-15 (WPL) - 2 (CHS W/P relay)
Below 1 Ω
WPL
Standard resistance (Check for short)
ECM Connector
A065744E36
ES
Engine Room
No. 2 Relay
Block
CHS W/P
Relay
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
2 (CHS W/P relay) or E7-15 (WPL) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(4) Reinstall the integration relay.
(5) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(b) Check the harness and the connectors between the CHS
water pump connector and the CHS W/P relay.
(1) Disconnect the CHS water pump connector.
(2) Remove the CHS W/P relay from the engine room
relay block No.2.
(3) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
2 (CHS water pump) - 5 (CHS W/P
relay)
Below 1 Ω
1 (CHS water pump) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
A082840E01
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
2 (CHS water pump) or 5 (CHS W/P
relay) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(4) Reconnect the CHS water pump connector.
(5) Reinstall the integration relay.
NG
OK
REPLACE ECM
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P2610
ES–397
ECM / PCM Internal Engine Off Timer Performance
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
To check the heat retention of the tank in the coolant heat storage (CHS) system, the ECM may cause the
water pump of the CHS system to operate 5 hours after the power switch has been turned OFF.
A timer and a clock are contained in the ECM internal circuit, and the timer starts when the power switch
is turned OFF (this process is called the "soak mode").
When the HV main system is started at the power switch, the ECM monitors its internal circuit. If the ECM
detects a deviation between the clock and the timer, or an abnormal condition during a comparison
between the starting history and the length of time the HV main power has been turned OFF, the ECM
determines that its internal circuit has malfunction and sets a DTC.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P2610
ECM internal error
•
ECM
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P2610: ECM internal engine off timer performance
Required sensors/components (main)
ECM
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
600 seconds
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
None
Engine
Running
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Case 1
Time internal engine off timer clock reads when CPU clock has
elapsed 600 seconds
Less than 420 seconds or more than 780 seconds
Case 2
Presents of history that ECM had woken up by internal engine off
timer
YES
Time period vehicle has been soaked
Less than programmed period
Case 3
Presents of history that ECM had woken up by internal engine off
timer
NO
Time period vehicle has been soaked
More than or equal to programmed period
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine condition when
malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was
running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or rich, and other data
from the time the malfunction occurred.
ES
ES–398
1
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
REPLACE ECM
NEXT
REPAIR COMPLETED
ES
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
ES–399
A/F Sensor Circuit Slow Response (Bank 1
Sensor 1)
P2A00
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P2195 (see page ES-344).
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P2A00
When A/F sensor output voltage change is
below compared to fuel trim change, ECM
judges that A/F sensor circuit response is
slow if conditions (a), (b) and (c) are met (2
trip detection logic):
(a) After engine is warmed up
(b) Engine speed is 1,100 rpm or more
(c) Vehicle speed 37.5 mph (60 km/h) or more
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Open or short in A/F sensor (bank 1
sensor 1) circuit
A/F sensor (bank 1 sensor 1)
A/F sensor heater
EFI M relay
A/F sensor heater and relay circuit
Air induction system
Fuel pressure
Injector
PCV hose connection
ECM
HINT:
Sensor 1 refers to the sensor mounted before the TWC and is located near the engine assembly.
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
Locus Length
A/F Output (V)
Fuel Trim
Fast Sensor
Slow Sensor
A082390E04
The air fuel-ratio (A/F) sensor varies its output voltage in proportion to the air-fuel ratio. Based on the
output voltage, the ECM determines if the air-fuel ratio is RICH or LEAN and adjusts the stoichiometric airfuel ratio.
The ECM also checks the fuel injection volume compensation value to check if the A/F sensor is
deteriorating or not. The output voltage variation, known as locus length, should be high when the air-fuel
ratio fluctuates.
ES
ES–400
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
When the A/F sensor response rate has deteriorated, the locus length should be short.
The ECM concludes that there is malfunction in the A/F sensor when the locus length is short and the
response rate has deteriorated.
MONITOR STRATEGY
ES
Related DTCs
P2A00: A/F sensor circuit slow response
Required sensors/components
Main:
A/F sensor
Related:
Engine speed sensor, vehicle speed sensor
Frequency of operation
Once per driving cycle
Duration
60 seconds
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
P0031, P0032 (A/F sensor heater - Sensor 1)
P0100 - P0103 (MAF meter)
P0110 - P0113 (IAT sensor)
P0115 - P0118 (ECT sensor)
P0120 - P0223, P2135 (TP sensor)
P0125 (Insufficient ECT for closed loop)
P0171, P0172 (Fuel system)
P0300 - P0304 (Misfire)
P0335 (CKP sensor)
P0340, P0341 (CMP sensor)
P0442 - P0456 (EVAP system)
P0500 (VSS)
P2196 (A/F sensor - Rationality)
Engine
Running
Time after first engine start
120 seconds
Fuel system status
Closed-loop
A/F sensor status
Activated
Idle
OFF
Time after idle off
2 seconds or more
Engine speed
1,100 rpm or more, and less than 3,400 rpm
Vehicle speed
37.5 mph (60 km/h) or more, and Less than 75 mph (120 km/h)
Fuel cut
OFF
Time after fuel cut is off
3 seconds or more
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Response rate deterioration level
8 or more
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Heated oxygen sensor heater current
MONITOR RESULT
Refer to detailed information (see page ES-15).
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P2195 (see page ES-347).
0.4 to 1.0 A (during idling and battery voltage 11 to 14 V)
ES–401
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Malfunctioning areas can be found by performing the ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL operation. The A/F
CONTROL operation can determine if the A/F sensor, heated oxygen sensor or other potential trouble
area are malfunctioning or not.
(a) Perform the ACTIVE TEST A/F CONTROL operation.
HINT:
The A/F CONTROL operation lowers the injection volume 12.5% or increases the injection volume 25%.
(1) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(3) Put the engine in inspection mode (see page ES-1).
(4) Warm up the engine by running the engine at 2,500 rpm, depressing the accelerator pedal more than
60% for approximately 90 seconds.
(5) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / A/F CONTROL.
(6) Perform the A/F CONTROL operation with the engine in an idle condition (press the right or left
button).
Result:
A/F sensor reacts in accordance with increase and decrease of injection volume:
+25% → rich output: Less than 3.0 V
-12.5% → lean output: More than 3.35 V
Heated oxygen sensor reacts in accordance with increase and decrease of injection volume:
+25% → rich output: More than 0.55 V
-12.5% → lean output: Less than 0.4 V
NOTICE:
The A/F sensor output has a few seconds of delay and the heated oxygen sensor output has about
20 seconds of delay at maximum.
Case
A/F Sensor (Sensor 1) Output Voltage
Main Suspected
Trouble Area
HO2 Sensor (Sensor 2) Output Voltage
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
Output Voltage
More than 0.55 V
Less than 0.4 V
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Output Voltage
More than 0.55 V
Less than 0.4 V
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
More than 3.35 V
Less than 3.0 V
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Injection Volume
+25%
-12.5%
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
Output Voltage
Almost
no reaction
-
1
2
3
4
•
•
•
A/F sensor
A/F sensor heater
A/F sensor circuit
•
•
•
HO2 sensor
HO2 sensor heater
HO2 sensor circuit
•
•
•
Fuel Injector
Fuel pressure
Gas leakage from
exhaust system (Airfuel ratio extremely
or lean rich)
ES
ES–402
ES
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
The following A/F CONTROL procedure enables the technician to check and graph the voltage output of
both A/F sensor and heated oxygen sensor.
To display the graph, enter ACTIVE TEST/ A/F CONTROL/USER DATA, select "AFS B1S1 and O2S
B1S2" by pressing the "YES" button followed by the "ENTER" button and then the "F4" button.
HINT:
• DTC P2A00 may be also detected, when the air-fuel ratio stays RICH or LEAN.
• Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine condition
when malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the
vehicle was running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or
rich, and other data from the time the malfunction occurred.
• A high A/F sensor voltage could be caused by a RICH air-fuel mixture. Check the conditions that would
cause the engine to run with the RICH air-fuel mixture.
• A low A/F sensor voltage could be caused by a LEAN air-fuel mixture. Check the conditions that would
cause the engine to run with the LEAN air-fuel mixture.
1
CHECK OTHER DTC OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO A/F SENSOR DTC)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P2A00
A
P2A00 and other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any other code besides P2A00 are output, perform
troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
A
2
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (OUTPUT VOLTAGE OF A/F SENSOR)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC 3.
(b) Put the engine in inspection mode (see page ES-1).
(c) Warm up the A/F sensors (bank 1 sensor 1) by running
the engine at 2,500 rpm with the accelerator pedal
depressed more than 60 % for approximately 90
seconds.
(d) Read A/F sensor voltage output on the intelligent tester.
(e) Enter the following menus: ENHANCED OBD II /
SNAPSHOT / MANUAL SNAPSHOT / USER DATA.
(f) Select "AFS B1 S1/ENGINE SPD" and press button
"YES".
(g) Monitor the A/F sensor voltage carefully.
(h) Check the A/F sensor voltage output under the following
conditions:
(1) Put the engine in inspection mode and allow the
engine to idle for 30 seconds.
ES–403
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(2) Put the engine in inspection mode and running the
engine at 2,500 rpm with the accelerator pedal
depressed more than 60% (where engine RPM is
not suddenly changed).
(3) Deactivate the inspection mode and drive the
vehicle with shift position "B" range.
(4) Accelerate the vehicle to 70 km/h (44 mph) and
quickly release the accelerator pedal so that the
throttle valve is fully closed.
CAUTION:
• Strictly observe of posted speed limits, traffic laws,
and road conditions when performing these drive
patterns.
• Do not drive the vehicle without deactivating
inspection mode, otherwise damaging the transaxle
may result.
OK:
Condition (1) and (2)
Voltage changes in the vicinity of 3.3 V (between
approximately 3.1 to 3.5 V) as shown in the illustration.
Condition (4)
A/F sensor voltage increases to 3.8 V or more during
engine deceleration (when fuel cut) as shown in the
illustration.
Malfunction Condition
Normal Condition
(4) Approximately 4,000 rpm
(2) 2,500 rpm
(2) 2,500 rpm
(1) Idle
(1) Idle
(4) Approximately
4,000 rpm
(1) Idle
(1) Idle
Engine
RPM
Engine
RPM
"Condition (3)"
3.8 V or More
A/F Sensor
Voltage
A/F Sensor
Voltage
Fuel Cut
"Condition (1), (2)"
Change in the vicinity of approximately 3.3 V
Fuel Cut
When A/F sensor circuit is malfunctioning,
voltage output does not change
A072304E10
HINT:
• Whenever the output voltage of the A/F sensor remains at
approximately 3.3 V (see diagram Malfunction Condition)
under any condition as well as the above conditions, the A/
F sensor may have an open-circuit. (This will happen also
when the A/F sensor heater has an open-circuit.)
ES
ES–404
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
• Whenever the output voltage of the A/F sensor remains at
a certain value of approximately 3.8 V or more, or 2.8 V or
less (see diagram Malfunction Condition) under any
condition as well as the above conditions, the A/F sensor
may have a short-circuit.
• The ECM will stop fuel injection (fuel cut) during engine
deceleration. This will cause a LEAN condition and should
result in a momentary increase in A/F sensor voltage
output.
• The ECM must establish a closed throttle position learned
value to perform fuel cut. If the battery terminal was
reconnected, the vehicle must be driven over 10 mph to
allow the ECM to learn the closed throttle position.
• When the vehicle is driven:
The output voltage of the A/F sensor may be below 2.8 V
during fuel enrichment. For the vehicle, this translates to a
sudden increase in speed with the accelerator pedal fully
depressed when trying to overtake another vehicle. The A/
F sensor is functioning normally.
• The A/F sensor is a current output element, and therefore
the current is converted into voltage inside the ECM. If
measuring voltage at connectors of A/F sensor or ECM,
you will observe a constant voltage.
ES
OK
Go to step 14
NG
3
INSPECT AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR (RESISTANCE OF A/F SENSOR HEATER)
(a) Disconnect the A5 A/F sensor connector.
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the A/F
sensor.
Standard resistance
Component Side
A/F Sensor Connector
HT
+B
A5
AF-
Front View
Resistance
1 (HT) - 2 (+B)
1.8 to 3.4 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
(c) Reconnect the A/F sensor connector.
AF+
A085152E51
OK
Tester Connection
NG
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
4
ES–405
INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY (EFI M RELAY)
Integration Relay
Connector
IGCT
HORN
AM2
IG2
EFI
EFI M
Relay Detail
8
7
6
1
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3K-1 - 3I-8
10 kΩ or higher
3K-1 - 3I-8
Below 1 Ω
(Apply battery voltage to terminals
3I-6 and 3I-7)
(c) Reinstall the integration relay.
3I
3I
3I
3K
6
7
8
1
(a) Remove the integration relay from the engine room relay
block.
(b) Inspect the EFI M relay.
Standard resistance
NG
REPLACE INTEGRATION RELAY
3I
3I
3I
3K
A082812E01
OK
5
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (A/F SENSOR - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the A5 A/F sensor connector.
Wire Harness Side
A/F Sensor Connector
A5
HT
+B
AF+
AFFront View
A085153E07
(b) Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E5
Tester Connection
HA1A
A1A+
A1AECM Connector
A065745E71
Specified Condition
A5-3 (AF+) - E5-23 (A1A+)
Below 1 Ω
A5-4 (AF-) - E5-22 (A1A-)
Below 1 Ω
A5-1 (HT) - E5-7 (HA1A)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A5-3 (AF+) or E5-23 (A1A+) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
ES
ES–406
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A5-4 (AF-) or E5-22 (A1A-) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
A5-1 (HT) or E5-7 (HA1A) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the A/F sensor connector.
(e) Reconnect the ECM connector.
Reference (Bank 1 Sensor 1 System Diagram)
ES
From
Battery
EFI
ECM
A/F Sensor
EFI M
HA1A
Heater
A1A+
Sensor
A1A-
Duty
Control
MREL
B062793E19
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
6
CHECK AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
(a) Check for vacuum leaks in the air induction system.
OK:
There is no leakage in the air induction system.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE AIR INDUCTION
SYSTEM
OK
7
CHECK CONNECTION OF PCV HOSE
OK:
PCV hose is connected correctly and PCV hose has no
damage.
NG
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE PCV HOSE
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
8
ES–407
CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
OK:
Fuel pressure: 304 to 343 kPa (3.1 to 3.5 kgf/cm2, 44 to
50 psi)
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FUEL SYSTEM
OK
9
INSPECT FUEL INJECTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the injector injection (high or low fuel injection
quantity or poor injection pattern).
OK:
Injection volume: 36 to 46 cm3 (2.1 to 2.8 cu in.) per
15 seconds.
NG
REPLACE FUEL INJECTOR ASSEMBLY
OK
10
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
GO
11
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
HINT:
Clear all DTCs prior to performing the confirmation driving
pattern (see page ES-347).
GO
12
READ OUTPUT DTC (SEE IF A/F SENSOR DTC IS OUTPUT AGAIN)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
No output
A
P2A00 again.
B
B
REPLACE ECM AND PERFORM
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
ES
ES–408
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
A
13
CONFIRM IF VEHICLE HAS RUN OUT OF FUEL IN PAST
OK:
Vehicle has run out of the fuel in the past.
NO
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
YES
ES
DTC IS CAUSED BY RUNNING OUT OF FUEL
14
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
HINT:
Clear all DTCs prior to performing the confirmation driving
pattern (see page ES-347).
GO
15
READ OUTPUT DTC (SEE IF A/F SENSOR DTC IS OUTPUT AGAIN)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P2A00
A
No output
B
B
Go to step 19
A
16
REPLACE AIR FUEL RATIO SENSOR
GO
17
PERFORM CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
HINT:
Clear all DTCs prior to performing the confirmation driving
pattern (see page ES-347).
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–409
GO
18
READ OUTPUT DTC (SEE IF A/F SENSOR DTC IS OUTPUT AGAIN)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
No output
A
P2A00
B
B
REPLACE ECM AND PERFORM
CONFIRMATION DRIVING PATTERN
A
19
CONFIRM IF VEHICLE HAS RUN OUT OF FUEL IN PAST
OK:
Vehicle has run out of the fuel in the past.
NO
YES
DTC IS CAUSED BY RUNNING OUT OF FUEL
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
ES
ES–410
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
P3190
Poor Engine Power
DTC
P3191
Engine dose not Start
DTC
P3193
Fuel Run Out
DESCRIPTION
ES
From the HV ECU, the ECM receives data such as power output required for the engine (required output),
estimated torque produced by the engine (estimated torque), engine RPM of control target (target RPM),
whether the engine is in start mode or not. Then, based on the required output and target RPM, the ECM
calculates a target torque that is to be produced by the engine and compares it with the estimated torque.
If the estimated torque is very low compared with the target torque, or the engine start mode continues for
the specific duration calculated by water temperature, an abnormal condition is detected.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
PP3190
Following conditions continue at a fixed
engine RPM or a fixed length of time:
• Communication with HV ECU is normal
• Engine RPM is a fixed value or more
• Engine start mode is not active
• Target torque is a fixed value
• Ratio of estimated torque against target
torque is less than 20%
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Air induction system
Throttle body
Fuel pressure
Engine
Mass Air flow meter
Out of fuel
Engine coolant temperature sensor
Crankshaft position sensor
Camshaft position sensor
ECM
PP3191
Following conditions continue at a fixed
engine RPM or a fixed length of time:
• Communication with HV ECU is normal
• Engine RPM is a fixed value or more
• Engine start mode is not active
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Air induction system
Throttle body
Fuel pressure
Engine
Mass Air flow meter
Out of fuel
Engine coolant temperature sensor
Crankshaft position sensor
Camshaft position sensor
ECM
PP3193
Following conditions are met:
• Fuel low level signal input into ECM
• Detection condition for P3190 or P3191 is
satisfied
•
•
Out of fuel
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM and HV control ECU are connected by a communication line called CAN. The ECM sends
information on the engine speed and other data to the HV control ECU while the HV control ECU sends
the information such as a requirement for the engine power to the ECM using the CAN communication
line.
When the communication between the ECM and HV control ECU is normal and the following items
becomes specific condition, the ECM will illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
(a) Engine speed
(b) Power switch
(c) Target torque
(d) Ratio of target torque against estimated torque
(e) Fuel level
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P3190: Poor engine power
P3191: Engine does not start
P3193: Fuel run out
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Required sensors/components
ES–411
Main sensors: Crankshaft position sensor
Related sensors: HV control ECU
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
100 engine revolutions and 6 seconds
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
None
Fuel cut operation
Not operated
Engine speed
750 rpm or more (varies with engine coolant temperature)
ES
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Case1: P3190
Time for low engine torque
100 engine revolutions or more, or 6 seconds or more
(varies with engine coolant temperature)
Case2: P3191
Engine start no-determination time (receive from HV ECU)
100 engine revolutions or more, and 6 seconds or more
(varies with engine coolant temperature)
Case3: P3193
Time for low engine torque or Engine start no-determination time
100 engine revolutions or more, and 6 seconds or more
(varies with engine coolant temperature)
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine condition when
malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was
running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or rich, and other data
from the time the malfunction occurred.
1
CHECK OTHER DTC OUTPUT (IN ADDITION TO DTC P3190, P3191 AND/OR P3193)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC output)
Proceed to
P3190, P3191 and/or P3193
A
P3190, P3191 and/or P3193, and
other DTCs
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides P3190, P3191 and/or P3193
are output, perform troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
B
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
ES–412
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
A
2
CHECK SHORTAGE OF FUEL
NG
REFILL FUEL
OK
3
CHECK AIR INDUCTION SYSTEM
OK:
The air induction system has no leakage and
blockages.
ES
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE AIR INDUCTION
SYSTEM
OK
4
CHECK FOR UNUSUAL NOISE OR VIBRATION WHEN STARTING ENGINE OR REVVING
UP
OK:
Unusual noise and vibration do not occur.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE
OK
5
CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
OK:
Fuel pressure: 304 to 343 kPa (3.1 to 3.5 kgf/cm2, 44 to
50 psi)
NG
OK
CHECK AND REPAIR FUEL SYSTEM
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
6
ES–413
INSPECT MASS AIR FLOW METER
Air
E2
VG
THA
+B
E2G
5 4 3 2 1
30
20
0.1
Acceptable
Sensor output voltage fluctuates
between 0.3 V and 4.8 V
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
4 (THA) - 5 (E2)
13.6 to 18.4 kΩ at -20°C (-4°F)
4 (THA) - 5 (E2)
2.21 to 2.69 kΩ at 20°C (68°F)
4 (THA) - 5 (E2)
0.49 to 0.67 kΩ at 60°C (140°F)
(d) Reinstall the mass air flow meter.
Temperature °C (°F)
NG
20 40 60 80 100
-20
0
(-4) (32) (68) (104) (140) (176) (212)
A060548E05
OK
Specified Condition
3 (VG) - 2 (E2G)
(c) Inspect resistance.
(1) Measure the resistance between the terminals of
the mass air flow meter.
Standard resistance
1
0.5
0.3
0.2
Tester Connection
Resistance kΩ
10
5
3
2
(a) Remove the mass air flow meter.
(b) Inspect output voltage.
(1) Apply battery voltage across terminals +B and E2G.
(2) Connect the positive (+) tester probe to terminal VG,
and negative (-) tester probe to terminal E2G.
(3) Blow air into the mass air flow meter, and check that
the voltage fluctuates.
Standard voltage
REPLACE MASS AIR FLOW METER
ES
ES–414
7
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
(a) Remove the engine coolant temperature sensor.
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the
engine coolant temperature sensor.
Standard resistance
Ohmmeter
Resistance
kΩ
ES
Acceptable
Temperature °C (°F)
A081700E08
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1-2
2 to 3 kΩ at 20°C (68°F)
1-2
0.2 to 0.4 kΩ at 80°C (176°F)
NOTICE:
When checking the engine coolant temperature sensor in
water, be careful not to allow water to contact the
terminals. After checking, dry the sensor.
HINT:
Alternate procedure: Connect an ohmmeter to the installed
engine coolant temperature sensor and read the resistance.
Use an infrared thermometer to measure the engine
temperature in the immediate vicinity of the sensor. Compare
these values to the resistance/temperature graph. Change
the engine temperature (warm up or allow to cool down) and
repeat the test.
(c) Reinstall the engine coolant temperature sensor.
NG
REPLACE ENGINE COOLANT
TEMPERATURE SENSOR
OK
8
INSPECT CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the C7 crankshaft position sensor connector.
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the
crankshaft position sensor connector.
Standard resistance
Component Side
Crankshaft Position Sensor
C7
Front View
A078431E13
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1-2
985 to 1,600 Ω at cold
1-2
1,265 to 1,890 Ω at hot
(c) Reconnect the crankshaft position sensor connector.
NOTICE:
Terms "cold" and "hot" refer to the temperature of
the sensor. "Cold" means approximately -10 to 50 °C
(14 to 122°F). "Hot" means approximately 50 to
100°C (122 to 212°F).
NG
OK
REPLACE CRANKSHAFT POSITION
SENSOR
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
9
ES–415
INSPECT CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the C1 camshaft position sensor connector.
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals of
camshaft position sensor connector.
Standard resistance
Component Side
Camshaft Position Sensor
C1
Front View
A073303E08
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1-2
1,630 to 2,740 Ω at cold
1-2
2,065 to 3,225 Ω at hot
(c) Reconnect the camshaft position sensor connector.
NOTICE:
Terms "cold" and "hot" refer to the temperature of
the sensor. "Cold" means approximately -10 to 50 °C
(14 to 122°F). "Hot" means approximately 50 to
100°C (122 to 212°F).
NG
REPLACE CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
OK
10
INSPECT THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR
(a) Disconnect the throttle control motor connector.
(b) Using an ohmmeter, measure the motor resistance
between terminals 1 (M-) and 2 (M+).
Standard resistance
Component Side
Throttle Control Motor Connector
T2
M+
M-
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1-2
0.3 to 100 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
NG
REPLACE THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR
A088591E01
OK
11
INSPECT THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
Component Side
VTA2
VTA1
E2
T3
VC
4 3 2 1
Front View
Throttle Position Sensor Connector
(a) Disconnect the throttle position sensor connector.
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the
throttle position sensor.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1 (VC) - 4 (E2)
1.2 to 3.2 kΩ at 20°C (68°F)
2 (VTA1) - 4 (E2)
1.8 to 10.5 kΩ at 20°C (68°F)
3 (VTA2) - 4 (E2)
1.8 to 10.5 kΩ at 20°C (68°F)
A054410E01
NG
REPLACE THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR
ES
ES–416
OK
REPLACE ECM
ES
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
DTC
U0293
ES–417
Lost Communication with HV ECU
DESCRIPTION
The Controller Area Network (CAN) is a serial data communication system for real-time application. It is a
multiplex communication system designed for on-vehicle use that provides a superior communication
speed of 500 kbps and a capability to detect malfunction. Through the combination of the CANH and
CANL bus lines, the CAN is able to maintain communication based on differential voltage.
HINT:
• Malfunction in the CAN bus (communication line) can be checked through the DLC3 connector, except
in case of an open circuit in the DLC3 sub bus line.
• DTCs pertaining to CAN communication can be accessed through the use of the intelligent tester II
(with CAN extension module).
• Malfunction in the DLC3 sub bus line cannot be detected through CAN communication, even though
the DLC3 connector is connected to CAN communication.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
U0293
When communication with HV ECU is
interrupted
•
•
•
Wire harness
HV ECU
ECM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The ECM and the HV control ECU are connected through a set of communication lines on the CAN, in
order to maintain mutual communication. The ECM uses the communication lines to transmit the engine
speed or other pieces of information to the HV control ECU. The HV control ECU transmits signals such
as a engine torque request signal to the ECM.
A few seconds after the power switch is turned ON (IG), the ECM starts checking for any malfunction in
the communication with the HV ECU. If the ECM detects a malfunction in the communication, the ECM
sets a DTC and illuminates the MIL.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
U0293: Lost communication with HV ECU
Required sensors/components
ECM
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
0.68 seconds
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
None
Power switch
ON
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Communication signal
No signal from HV ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to CAN Communication System (see page CA-4).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Refer to CAN Communication System (see page CA-6).
ES
ES–418
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
HINT:
Read freeze frame data using the intelligent tester. Freeze frame data records the engine condition when
malfunction is detected. When troubleshooting, freeze frame data can help determine if the vehicle was
running or stopped, if the engine was warmed up or not, if the air-fuel ratio was lean or rich, and other data
from the time the malfunction occurred.
ES
ES–419
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ECM Power Source Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The power source circuit of the hybrid system differs from the conventional power source circuit in the
method in which the battery voltage is supplied to IGSW terminal of the ECM. The hybrid system has
adopted one relay to serve as the power switch, which is controlled by the power source control ECU.
When the HV system is turned ON, the power source control ECU actuates the IG2 relay, which applies
the battery voltage to IGSW terminal of the ECM. This causes the MREL terminal to transmit a signal to
the EFI M relay. Then, the current that passes through the contact points of the EFI M relay (which is
actuated by the MREL signal) flows to the +B terminal of the ECM.
When the power switch is turned OFF, the ECM keeps the EFI M relay ON for a maximum of 2 seconds,
in order to initialize the throttle valve.
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
Driver Side Junction Block
IGN
IGSW
IG2D
Power Source Control ECU
+B
MREL
IG2
P/I
EFI
AM2
MAIN
Fusible
Link Block
EFI M Engine Room
Relay Block
E1
A127923E01
ES
ES–420
1
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK ECM (+B VOLTAGE)
E5
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Measure the voltage between the specified terminals of
the E5 and E7 ECM connectors.
Standard voltage
E7
E1 (-)
+B (+)
ECM Connector
ES
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E7-4 (+B) - E5-28 (E1)
9 to 14 V
OK
A124045E12
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN ON PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NG
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (ECM - BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the E5 ECM connector.
(b) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E5
E1
ECM Connector
A065745E47
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E5-28 (E1) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
(c) Reconnect the ECM connector.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
3
CHECK ECM (IGSW VOLTAGE)
E5
E6
E1 (-)
IGSW (+)
ECM Connector
A124045E13
NG
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Measure the voltage between the specified terminals of
the E5 and E6 ECM connectors.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E6-9 (IGSW) - E5-28 (E1)
9 to 14 V
OK
Go to step 7
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
4
ES–421
INSPECT FUSE (IGN FUSE)
(a) Remove the IGN fuse from the driver side junction block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the IGN fuse.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
(c) Reinstall the IGN fuse.
Driver Side Junction Block
NG
CHECK FOR SHORT IN ALL HARNESS AND
COMPONENTS CONNECTED TO FUSE
IGN Fuse
ES
A082809E01
OK
5
INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY (IG2 RELAY)
Integration Relay
Connector
IGCT
HORN
AM2
2 3I
3 3I
4 3I
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3K-1 - 3I-4
10 kΩ or higher
3K-1 - 3I-4
Below 1 Ω
(Apply battery voltage to terminals
3I-2 and 3I-3)
(c) Reinstall the integration relay.
NG
IG2
EFI
EFI M
4 3I
2 3I
3 3I
1 3K
Relay Detail
A082812E02
OK
(a) Remove the integration relay from the engine room relay
block.
(b) Inspect the EFI M relay.
Standard resistance
REPLACE INTEGRATION RELAY
ES–422
6
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECT FUSE (AM2 FUSE)
(a) Remove the AM2 fuse from the engine room relay block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the AM2 fuse.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
(c) Reinstall the AM2 fuse.
Engine Room Relay Block
NG
AM2 Fuse
ES
CHECK FOR SHORT IN ALL HARNESS AND
COMPONENTS CONNECTED TO FUSE
A088628E01
OK
CHECK AND REPAIR HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (BATTERY - IG2 RELAY, IG2 RELAY - ECM)
7
CHECK ECM (MREL VOLTAGE)
E5
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Measure the voltage between the specified terminals of
the E5 and E7 ECM connectors.
Standard voltage
E7
E1 (-)
MREL (+)
ECM Connector
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E7-7 (MREL) - E5-28 (E1)
9 to 14 V
NG
REPLACE ECM
A124045E14
OK
8
INSPECT FUSE (EFI FUSE)
(a) Remove the EFI fuse from the engine room relay block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the EFI fuse.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
(c) Reinstall the EFI fuse.
Engine Room Relay Block
NG
EFI Fuse
A082798E01
OK
CHECK FOR SHORT IN ALL HARNESS AND
COMPONENTS CONNECTED TO FUSE
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
9
ES–423
INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY (EFI M RELAY)
Integration Relay
Connector
IGCT
HORN
AM2
IG2
EFI
8
7
6
1
EFI M
Relay Detail
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3K-1 - 3I-8
10 kΩ or higher
3K-1 - 3I-8
Below 1 Ω
(Apply battery voltage to terminals
3I-6 and 3I-7)
(c) Reinstall the integration relay.
3I
3I
3I
3K
6
7
8
1
(a) Remove the integration relay from the engine room relay
block.
(b) Inspect the EFI M relay.
Standard resistance
NG
REPLACE INTEGRATION RELAY
3I
3I
3I
3K
A082812E01
OK
10
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (EFI M RELAY - ECM, EFI M RELAY - BODY
GROUND)
(a) Check the harness and connectors between the EFI M
relay and ECM connector.
(1) Remove the integration relay from the engine room
relay block.
7 3I
6 3I
Engine Room Relay Block
A082810E03
(2) Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
(3) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Wire Harness Side
E7
MREL
ECM Connector
A065744E39
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3I-6 (EFI M relay) - E7-7 (MREL)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3I-6 (EFI M relay) or E7-7 (MREL) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(4) Reinstall the integration relay.
ES
ES–424
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
(5) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(b) Check the harness and the connectors between the EFI
M relay and the body ground.
(1) Remove the integration relay from the engine room
relay block.
(2) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connector and the body ground.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3I-7 (EFI M relay) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
(3) Reinstall the integration relay.
NG
ES
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
CHECK AND REPAIR HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (TERMINAL +B OF ECM - BATTERY
POSITIVE TERMINAL)
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–425
VC Output Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The VC voltage (5 V) is generated in the ECM. The voltage is used to supply power to the throttle position
sensor, canister pump module, etc.
ES
ES–426
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
Throttle Position Sensor (Built into Throttle Body)
VC
VC
VTA
VTA1
VTA2
VTA2
ES
E2
Canister Pump Module
VCC
Canister
Pressure
Sensor
VOUT
PPMP
SGND
Water Valve
WSAD
WBAD
VC
E2
E2
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor
VCC
E2
PTNK
PTNK
A128755E01
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–427
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK MIL
(a) Check that MIL (Malfunction Indicator Lamp) lights up
when turning the power switch ON (IG).
OK:
MIL lights up
OK
SYSTEM IS OK
NG
2
ES
CHECK CONNECTION BETWEEN INTELLIGENT TESTER AND ECM
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and turn the intelligent
tester ON.
(c) Check the connection between the intelligent tester and
ECM.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
Communication is possible
A
Communication is not possible
B
A
GO TO MIL CIRCUIT
B
3
CHECK ECM (VC VOLTAGE)
E4
VC (+)
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Measure the voltage of the ECM connector.
Standard voltage
E5
Tester Connection
Proceed to
E4-18 (VC) - E5-28 (E1)
Voltage is not 5 V
E1 (-)
A119979E47
NEXT
4
CHECK MIL (THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR)
(a) Disconnect the T3 throttle body connector.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Check the MIL.
ES–428
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Result
Condition
Proceed to
MIL illuminates
A
MIL does not illuminate
B
A
REPLACE THROTTLE BODY
B
5
CHECK MIL (WATER VALVE)
(a) Disconnect the W5 water valve connector.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Check the MIL.
Result
ES
Condition
Proceed to
MIL illuminates
A
MIL does not illuminate
B
A
REPLACE WATER VALVE
B
6
CHECK MIL (CANISTER PUMP MODULE)
(a) Disconnect the V7 canister pump module connector.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Check the MIL.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
MIL illuminates
A
MIL does not illuminate
B
A
REPLACE CHARCOAL CANISTER
ASSEMBLY
B
7
CHECK MIL (VAPOR PRESSURE SENSOR)
(a) Disconnect the V6 vapor pressure sensor connector.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Check the MIL.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
MIL illuminates
A
MIL does not illuminate
B
A
REPLACE VAPOR PRESSURE SENSOR
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–429
B
8
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (ECM - BODY GROUND)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
E4
VC
ECM Connector
A065743E90
Disconnect the T3 throttle body connector.
Disconnect the W5 water valve connector.
Disconnect the V7 canister pump module connector.
Disconnect the V6 vapor pressure sensor connector.
Disconnect the E4 ECM connector.
Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E4-18 (VC) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
OK
REPLACE ECM
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
ES
ES–430
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
Fuel Pump Control Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The fuel pump is operated by the ECM according to the vehicle running condition. After the ECM receives
the engine start requirement signal from the HV control ECU, an NE signal comes in immediately when
the engine is cranked by MG1 (basically, the fuel pump can operate while the NE signal is generated).
The ECM grounds the FC terminal line after receiving NE signal. It causes to energize the coil in the
circuit opening relay, and the current flows to the fuel pump.
When the signal to stop the engine comes from the HV control ECU to the ECM, or when the fuel cut
operation is performed such as decelerating by the engine brake, the fuel pump is stopped.
ES
ES–431
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
Engine Room
Relay Block
IGSW
ES
FC
C/OPN
IGN
From EFI M
Relay
E1
Power Source Control ECU
M
Fuel Pump
IG2D
MAIN
P/I
AM2
IG2
Fusible Link Block
Engine Room Relay Block
A127924E01
ES–432
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (OPERATE CIRCUIT OPENING
RELAY)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / ACTIVE TEST / FUEL PUMP / SPD.
(e) Check the relay operation while operating it with the
tester.
OK:
Operating noise can be heard from the relay.
ES
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEMS TABLE
NG
2
INSPECT POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE POWER SOURCE
CIRCUIT COMPONENTS
OK
3
INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY (C/OPN RELAY)
Integration Relay
Connector
AC W/P
BK/UP
FAN
C/OPN
Relay Detail
5
6
7
8
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3G-5 - 3G-8
10 kΩ or higher
3G-5 - 3G-8
Below 1 Ω
(Apply battery voltage to terminals
3G-6 and 3G-7)
(c) Reinstall the integration relay.
3G
3G
NG
3G
3G
5
8
7
6
(a) Remove the integration relay from the engine room relay
block.
(b) Inspect the circuit opening relay.
Standard resistance
3G
3G
3G
3G
A082815E01
REPLACE INTEGRATION RELAY
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–433
OK
4
CHECK ECM (FC VOLTAGE)
E5
E6
E1 (-)
FC (+)
ECM Connector
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Measure the voltage between the specified terminals of
the E5 and E6 ECM connectors.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E6-10 (FC) - E5-28 (E1)
9 to 14 V
GO
Go to step 5
A124045E15
NG
CHECK AND REPAIR HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
5
INSPECT FUEL PUMP
(a) Disconnect the F14 fuel pump connector.
(b) Inspect the fuel pump resistance.
(1) Measure the resistance between terminals 3 and 7.
Standard resistance
Component Side
Fuel Pump Connector
(+)
F14
(-)
Fuel Pump
A082833E03
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-7
0.2 to 3.0 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
(c) Inspect the fuel pump operation.
(1) Apply battery voltage to the fuel pump terminals.
Check that the pump operates.
NOTICE:
• These tests must be done quickly (within 10 seconds)
to prevent the coil from burning out.
• Keep fuel pump as far away from the battery as
possible.
• Always do the switching at the battery side.
(d) Reconnect the fuel pump connector.
NG
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE FUEL TANK
ASSEMBLY
ES
ES–434
6
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (C/OPN RELAY - FUEL PUMP, FUEL PUMP - BODY
GROUND)
(a) Check the harness and the connectors between the
circuit opening relay and the fuel pump connector.
(1) Remove the integration relay from the engine room
relay block.
(2) Disconnect the F14 fuel pump connector.
(3) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Engine Room Relay Block
8 3G
ES
A082811E01
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3G-8 (Circuit opening relay) - F14-3
(Fuel pump)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Specified Condition
3G-8 (Circuit opening relay ) or F14-3
(Fuel pump) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(4) Reinstall the integration relay.
(5) Reconnect the fuel pump connector.
(b) Check the harness and the connectors between the fuel
pump connector and the body ground.
(1) Disconnect the F14 fuel pump connector.
(2) Measure the resistance between the wire harness
side connector and the body ground.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Wire Harness Side
Fuel Pump Connector
(+)
1 2 3 4
F14
Tester Connection
5 6 7 8
(-)
Front View
A082834E01
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
F14-7 (Fuel pump) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
(3) Reconnect the fuel pump connector.
NG
OK
REPLACE ECM
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–435
MIL Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The IG2 relay energized by the power source control ECU applies the battery voltage to the malfunction
indicator lamp (MIL) in the combination meter while the main system is turned ON.
When it is necessary, the ECM grounds the W terminal line and illuminates the MIL.
In order to perform functional check visually, the MIL is illuminated when the power switch is first turned
ON (IG).
If the MIL is ON or OFF all of the time, use the procedure below to troubleshoot it. The MIL is used to
indicate vehicle malfunction which was detected by the ECM. Follow this procedure using the intelligent
tester or the OBD II scan tool to determine cause of the problem and to check the MIL.
ES
ES–436
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
ECM
IGN
W
Driver Side Junction Block
Combination Meter
ES
MIL
Engine Room
Relay Block
P/I
AM2
IG2
IG2D
Power Source
Control ECU
MAIN
Fusible Link
Block
AM2
A127925E02
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
ES–437
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK MIL CONDITION
(a) Perform troubleshooting in accordance with the chart
below.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
MIL remains ON
A
MIL does not illuminate
B
B
Go to step 4
A
2
CLEAR DTC
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
(f)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power ON (IG).
Turn the tester ON.
Read DTCs (see page ES-29).
Clear the DTCs (see page ES-29).
Check the MIL is not illuminated.
OK:
MIL is not illuminated.
OK
REPAIR CIRCUITS INDICATED BY OUTPUT
DTCS
NG
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (CHECK FOR SHORT IN WIRE HARNESS)
(a) Disconnect the E6 ECM connector.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Check the MIL is not illuminated.
OK:
MIL is not illuminated.
(d) Reconnect the ECM connector.
E6
OK
REPLACE ECM
ECM Connector
A065748E33
NG
CHECK AND REPAIR HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (COMBINATION METER - ECM)
ES
ES–438
4
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – SFI SYSTEM
CHECK THAT MIL IS ILLUMINATED
(a) Check that MIL is illuminated when the power switch is
turned ON (IG).
Standard:
MIL is illuminated.
OK
SYSTEM OK
NG
ES
5
CHECK THAT ENGINE STARTS
(a) Turn the power switch to ON (IG).
(b) Start the engine.
Result
Result
Proceed To
Engine starts
A
Engine does not start*
B
HINT:
*: The intelligent tester cannot communicate with the
ECM.
B
GO TO VC OUTPUT CIRCUIT
A
6
INSPECT COMBINATION METER ECU (MIL CIRCUIT)
(a) See the combination meter troubleshooting (see page
ME-11).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE BULB OR
COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
OK
CHECK AND REPAIR HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (COMBINATION METER - ECM)
ES–432
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – MASS AIR FLOW METER
MASS AIR FLOW METER
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
ES
MASS AIR FLOW
METER CONNECTOR
O-RING
MASS AIR FLOW METER
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A112275E01
ES–433
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – MASS AIR FLOW METER
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
NOTICE:
• Perform the MAF meter inspection according to the
procedures below.
• Only replace the MAF meter when both the LONG
FT#1 value and MAF value in the DATA LIST (with the
engine stopped) are not within the normal operating
range.
1.
Intelligent Tester
CAN VIM
DLC3
A087542E04
CHECK MASS AIR FLOW METER
(a) Perform confirmation driving pattern.
(1) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the power switch ON.
(3) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(4) Clear the DTCs (see page ES-29).
(5) Start the engine and warm it up with all
accessory switches OFF (until the engine
coolant temperature is 75°C (167°F) or more).
(6) Drive the vehicle at 50 km/h (31 mph) or more
for 3 minutes or more*1.
(7) Let the engine to idle (accelerator pedal fully
released) for 2 minutes or more*2.
(8) Perform steps *1 and *2 at least 3 times.
(Vehicle Speed)
*1
*1
*1
50 km/h (31 mph)
Idling
Power Switch OFF
*2
Warming up
*2
*2
*1: 3 to 5 minutes
*2: 2 minutes
A116436E07
(b) Read value using intelligent tester (LONG FT#1).
(1) Enter the following menus: Powertrain / Engine
and ECT / Data List / Long FT#1.
(2) Read the values displayed on the tester.
Standard value:
Within -15 to +15 %
If the result is not within the specified range,
perform the inspection below.
ES
ES–434
ES
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – MASS AIR FLOW METER
(c) Read value using intelligent tester (MAF).
NOTICE:
• Turn off the engine.
• Perform the inspection with the vehicle
indoors and on a level surface.
• Perform the inspection of the MAF meter
while it is installed to the air cleaner case
(installed to the vehicle).
• During the test, do not use the exhaust air
duct to perform suction on the exhaust pipe.
(1) Turn the power switch ON (ACC).
(2) Turn the power switch ON (do not start the
engine).
(3) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(4) Enter the following menus: Powertrain / Engine
and ECT / Data List / MAF.
(5) Wait 30 seconds, and read the values on the
intelligent tester.
Standard condition:
Less than 0.07 g/sec.
• If the result is not as specified, replace the
MAF meter.
• If the result is within the specified range,
inspect the cause of the extremely rich or
lean air fuel ratio (see page ES-128).
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – MASS AIR FLOW METER
ES–435
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
(See page ES-450)
3.
REMOVE MASS AIR FLOW METER
(a) Disconnect the MAF meter connector.
(b) Remove the 2 screws and MAF meter.
A087413E01
INSTALLATION
A087413E01
1.
INSTALL MASS AIR FLOW METER
(a) Install a new O-ring to the MAF meter.
(b) Install the MAF meter with the 2 screws.
(c) Connect the MAF meter connector.
2.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
3.
INSTALL RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
(See page ES-454)
4.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
ES
ES–436
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE
ASSEMBLY
CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
ES
AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
7.0 (71, 62 in.*lbf)
3.0 (31, 27 in.*lbf)
O-RING
CAMSHAFT TIMING
OIL CONTROL VALVE
CONNECTOR
CAMSHAFT TIMING
OIL CONTROL VALVE
ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A112276E01
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE
ASSEMBLY
ES–437
REMOVAL
A087587E01
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
(See page ES-450)
3.
REMOVE AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY (See page ES450)
4.
REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE
ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the camshaft timing oil control valve
connector.
(b) Remove the bolt and camshaft timing oil control
valve.
ES
ES–438
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE
ASSEMBLY
INSPECTION
1.
1
INSPECT CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE
ASSEMBLY
(a) Measure the resistance of the oil control valve.
Standard resistance:
6.9 to 7.9 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
If the result is not as specified, replace the camshaft
timing oil control valve assembly.
(b) Inspect the operation.
(1) Connect the battery positive (+) lead to terminal
1 and negative (-) lead to terminal 2, and
inspect the movement of the valve.
Specified condition
2
Valve
ES
Condition
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) voltage is applied
Valve moves in black arrow direction
shown in illustration
Battery positive (+) voltage is cut off
Valve moves in white arrow direction
shown in illustration
A050377E02
If the result is not as specified, replace the
camshaft timing oil control valve assembly.
NOTICE:
Confirm that the valve moves freely and is
not stuck in any position.
HINT:
Foreign objects in the oil can cause subtle
pressure leaks in the valve. The pressure leaks
will cause the cam to advance. This condition
will usually set a DTC.
INSTALLATION
New
O-Ring
1.
INSTALL CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE
ASSEMBLY
(a) Apply a light coat of engine oil to a new O-ring, then
install it to the camshaft timing oil control valve.
(b) Install the camshaft timing oil control valve with the
bolt.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (76 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Be careful that the O-ring is not cracked or
jammed when installing it.
(c) Connect the camshaft timing oil control valve
connector.
2.
INSTALL AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY (See page ES453)
3.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
4.
CHECK FOR ENGINE OIL LEAKS
5.
INSTALL RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
(See page ES-454)
A087549E02
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE
ASSEMBLY
6.
ES–439
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
ES
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
ES–439
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
ES
INVERTER COVER
INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
CONNECTOR
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A112339E01
ES–440
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
(See page ES-450)
2.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
3.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
4.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-6)
5.
DRAIN HV COOLANT (See page HX-58)
6.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
7.
REMOVE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
(a) Remove the inverter with converter (see page HV530).
8.
REMOVE CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the sensor connector.
(b) Remove the bolt and sensor.
ES
INSPECTION
1.
A073303E09
INSPECT CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Measure the resistance of the sensor.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
Cold
1,630 to 2,740 Ω
1-2
Hot
2,065 to 3,225 Ω
NOTICE:
The terms "Cold" and "Hot" refer to the
temperature of the sensor. "Cold" means
approximately -10 to 50°C (14 to 122°F). "Hot"
means approximately 50 to 100°C (122 to 212°F).
If the result is not as specified, replace the camshaft
position sensor.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
ES–441
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Install the sensor with the bolt.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (76 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
(b) Connect the sensor connector.
2.
INSTALL INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
(a) Install the inverter with converter (see page HV535).
3.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
4.
ADD HV COOLANT (See page HX-58)
5.
ADD ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-7)
6.
CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS (See page
CO-2)
7.
CHECK FOR HV COOLANT LEAKS
8.
INSTALL RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
(See page ES-454)
9.
INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
10. INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
11. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
ES
ES–442
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
ES
20 (204, 15)
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
CONNECTOR
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A112274E01
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
ES–443
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
3.
REMOVE CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the sensor connector.
(b) Remove the bolt and sensor.
INSPECTION
1.
A078431E11
ES
INSPECT CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Measure the resistance of the sensor.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
Cold
985 to 1,600 Ω
1-2
Hot
1,265 to 1,890 Ω
NOTICE:
The terms "Cold" and "Hot" refer to the
temperature of the sensor. "Cold" means
approximately -10 to 50°C (14 to 122°F). "Hot"
means approximately 50 to 100°C (122 to 212°F).
If the result is not as specified, replace the
crankshaft position sensor.
ES–444
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
INSTALLATION
ES
1.
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Install the sensor with the bolt.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (76 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
(b) Connect the sensor connector.
2.
INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
3.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
4.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
ES–444
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
ES
ENGINE COOLANT
TEMPERATURE SENSOR
CONNECTOR
INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
20 (204, 15)
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE
SENSOR
GASKET
ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A112277E01
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
ES–445
REMOVAL
CAUTION:
The hybrid system uses high voltage circuits, so
improper handling could cause an electric shock or
leakage. During servicing (e.g. installing or removing the
parts, replacing the parts), be sure to follow the
procedures below.
19 mm Deep Socket Wrench
A087601E02
1.
REMOVE RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
(See page ES-450)
2.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
3.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
4.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-6)
5.
DRAIN HV COOLANT (See page HX-58)
6.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
7.
REMOVE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
(a) Remove the inverter with converter (see page HV530).
8.
REMOVE ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE
SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the sensor connector.
(b) Using a 19 mm deep socket wrench, remove the
sensor and gasket.
ES
ES–446
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE
SENSOR
(a) Measure the resistance of the sensor.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
20°C (68°F)
2.32 to 2.59 kΩ
1-2
80°C (176°F)
0.310 to 0.326 kΩ
NOTICE:
If checking the sensor in water, be careful not to
allow water to contact the terminals. After
checking, dry the sensor.
ES
(kΩ)
Resistance
(°C)
(°F)
Temperature
)
A114177E01
If the result is not as specified, replace the engine
coolant temperature sensor.
INSTALLATION
19 mm Deep Socket Wrench
1.
INSTALL ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE
SENSOR
(a) Using a 19 mm deep socket wrench, install a new
gasket and the sensor.
Torque: 20 N*m (204 kgf*cm, 15 ft.*lbf)
(b) Connect the sensor connector.
2.
INSTALL INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
(a) Install the inverter with converter (see page HV535).
3.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
4.
ADD ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-7)
5.
ADD HV COOLANT (See page HX-58)
A087601E02
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
ES–447
6.
CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS (See page
CO-2)
7.
CHECK FOR HV COOLANT LEAKS
8.
INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
9.
INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
10. INSTALL RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
(See page ES-454)
11. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
ES
ES–448
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – THROTTLE BODY
THROTTLE BODY
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
x2
ES
7.0 (71, 62 in.*lbf)
NO. 1 AIR CLEANER INLET
3.0 (31, 27 in.*lbf)
MASS AIR FLOW METER
CONNECTOR
3.0 (31, 27 in.*lbf)
x6
RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
x2
x4
x3
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A112278E01
ES–449
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – THROTTLE BODY
NO. 1 VENTILATION HOSE
NO. 2 VENTILATION HOSE
20 (204, 15)
NO. 1 FUEL VAPOR
FEED HOSE
ES
THROTTLE BODY
ASSEMBLY WITH
MOTOR
THROTTLE CONTROL
MOTOR CONNECTOR
NO. 1 WATER BY-PASS HOSE
THROTTLE POSITION
SENSOR CONNECTOR
NO. 2 WATER BY-PASS
HOSE
GASKET
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A112279E01
ES–450
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – THROTTLE BODY
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
3.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-6)
4.
REMOVE RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
(a) Remove the 6 clips and radiator support opening
cover.
5.
REMOVE AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the MAF meter connector.
(b) Disconnect the wire harness from the wire harness
clamp.
(c) Loosen the hose clamp bolt, and then disconnect
the No. 1 air cleaner inlet.
ES
A087414E01
A087415E01
(d) Remove the 2 bolts.
(e) Loosen the hose clamp bolt, and then remove the
air cleaner.
Hose Clamp Bolt
A087416E02
6.
A087573E01
REMOVE THROTTLE BODY ASSEMBLY WITH
MOTOR
(a) Disconnect the ventilation hose.
(b) Disconnect the No. 2 ventilation hose.
(c) Disconnect the No. 1 fuel vapor feed hose.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – THROTTLE BODY
ES–451
(d) Disconnect the water by-pass hose.
(e) Disconnect the No. 2 water by-pass hose.
A087574E01
(f) Disconnect the throttle control motor connector.
(g) Disconnect the throttle position sensor connector.
A087575E01
(h) Remove the bolt, 2 nuts and throttle with motor
body.
A087576E01
(i)
A087577E02
Remove the gasket from the intake manifold.
ES
ES–452
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – THROTTLE BODY
INSPECTION
1.
Throttle Valve
ES
INSPECT THROTTLE WITH MOTOR BODY
ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the appearance.
(1) Check that the throttle valve shaft does not
rattle.
(2) Check that each port is not clogged.
(3) Check that the throttle valve opens and closes
smoothly.
(4) Check that there is no clearance between the
throttle stop screw and lever when the throttle
valve is fully closed.
NOTICE:
Do not adjust the throttle stop screw.
Throttle Valve
Shaft
Throttle Stop Screw
Lever
A088226E01
(b) Inspect the resistance of the throttle control motor.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance
between the terminals.
Standard resistance:
50 MΩ or more at 25°C (77°F)
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the
throttle with motor body.
A087470E02
(c) Inspect the resistance of the throttle position sensor.
(1) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance
between terminals 1 and 4.
Standard resistance:
1.2 to 3.5 kΩ at 25°C (77°F)
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the
throttle with motor body.
A114365
INSTALLATION
1.
A087577E02
INSTALL THROTTLE BODY ASSEMBLY WITH
MOTOR
(a) Install a new gasket to the intake manifold.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – THROTTLE BODY
ES–453
(b) Install the throttle with motor body with the bolt and
2 nuts.
Torque: 20 N*m (204 kgf*cm, 15 ft.*lbf)
A087576E01
(c) Connect the throttle position sensor connector.
(d) Connect the throttle control motor connector.
A087575E01
(e) Connect the No. 2 water by-pass hose.
(f) Connect the water by-pass hose.
A087574E01
(g) Connect the No. 1 fuel vapor feed hose.
(h) Connect the No. 2 ventilation hose.
(i) Connect the ventilation hose.
A087573E01
2.
Hose Clamp Bolt
A087416E02
INSTALL AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the air cleaner with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 7.0 N*m (71 kgf*cm, 62 in.*lbf)
(b) Tighten the hose clamp bolt.
Torque: 3.0 N*m (31 kgf*cm, 27 in.*lbf)
(c) Connect the No. 1 air cleaner inlet, and tighten the
hose clamp bolt.
Torque: 3.0 N*m (31 kgf*cm, 27 in.*lbf)
(d) Connect the MAF meter connector.
ES
ES–454
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – THROTTLE BODY
ES
A087414E01
3.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
4.
ADD ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-7)
5.
CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS (See page
CO-2)
6.
INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
7.
INSTALL RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
(a) Install the cover with the 6 clips.
8.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – KNOCK SENSOR
ES–455
KNOCK SENSOR
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
x2
7.0 (71, 62 in.*lbf)
ES
NO. 1 AIR CLEANER INLET
3.0 (31, 27 in.*lbf)
MAF METER CONNECTOR
3.0 (31, 27 in.*lbf)
x6
RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
x2
x4
x3
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A112278E02
ES–456
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – KNOCK SENSOR
NO. 1 VENTILATION HOSE
NO. 2 VENTILATION HOSE
INTAKE MANIFOLD SUB-ASSEMBLY
20 (204, 15)
20 (204, 15)
NO. 1 FUEL VAPOR FEED HOSE
ES
GASKET
NO. 1 WATER BY-PASS HOSE
NO. 2 WATER BY-PASS HOSE
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
ENGINE HARNESS
- THROTTLE CONTROL MOTOR CONNECTOR
- THROTTLE POSITION SENSOR CONNECTOR
OIL DIPSTICK
OIL DIPSTICK GUIDE
O-RING
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
20 (204, 15)
KNOCK SENSOR
KNOCK SENSOR CONNECTOR
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A112281E01
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – KNOCK SENSOR
ES–457
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
(See page ES-450)
3.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
4.
DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-6)
5.
REMOVE AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY (See page ES450)
6.
REMOVE OIL DIPSTICK GUIDE
(a) Remove the dipstick.
(b) Disconnect the wire harness clamp.
(c) Remove the bolt and dipstick guide.
7.
REMOVE INTAKE MANIFOLD SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the ventilation hose from the throttle
with motor body.
(b) Disconnect the No. 2 ventilation hose.
(c) Disconnect the No. 1 fuel vapor feed hose.
A087582E01
A087573E01
(d) Disconnect the water by-pass hose.
(e) Disconnect the No. 2 water by-pass hose.
A087574E01
ES
ES–458
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – KNOCK SENSOR
(f) Disconnect the throttle control motor connector.
(g) Disconnect the throttle position sensor connector.
A087575E01
(h) Disconnect the 3 wire harness clamps.
(i) Disconnect the connector clamp.
(j) Remove the bolt and harness clamp bracket.
ES
A087583E01
(k) Remove the No. 1 fuel vapor feed hose from the
hose clamp.
(l) Remove the 3 bolts, 2 nuts and intake manifold.
A087584E01
(m) Remove the gasket from the cylinder head.
A087585E01
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – KNOCK SENSOR
8.
ES–459
REMOVE KNOCK SENSOR
(a) Disconnect the knock sensor connector.
(b) Remove the nut and sensor.
A087586E01
INSPECTION
1.
A065174E05
INSPECT KNOCK SENSOR
(a) Measure the resistance of the sensor.
Standard resistance:
120 to 280 kΩ at 20°C (68°F)
If the result is not as specified, replace the knock
sensor.
• A flat type knock sensor (non-resonant type) has
a structure that can detect vibrations between
approximately 6 kHz and 15 kHz.
• Knock sensors are fitted onto the engine block to
detect engine knocking.
• The knock sensor contains a piezoelectric
element which generates a voltage when it
becomes deformed. The voltage is generated
when the engine block vibrates due to knocking.
Any occurrence of engine knocking can be
suppressed by delaying the ignition timing.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0327
Output voltage of knock sensor is 0.5 V or
less
(1 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
Short in knock sensor circuit
Knock sensor
ECM
P0328
Output voltage of knock sensor is 4.5 V or
more
(1 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
Open in knock sensor circuit
Knock sensor
ECM
HINT:
When either of the DTCs P0327 and P0328 are set,
the ECM enters fail-safe mode. During fail-safe
mode, the power timing is delayed to its maximum
retardation. Fail-safe mode continues until the
power switch OFF.
Reference: Inspection using an oscilloscope.
The correct waveform is shown.
KNK1 Signal Waveform
GND
A085286E13
Items
Contents
Terminals
KNK1 - EKNK
Equipment Settings
0.01 to 10 V/Division, 0.01 to 10 msec./
Division
Conditions
Keep engine speed at 4,000 rpm with
warm engine
ES
ES–460
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – KNOCK SENSOR
INSTALLATION
Upper
1.
INSTALL KNOCK SENSOR
(a) Install the knock sensor with the nut.
Torque: 20 N*m (204 kgf*cm, 15 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Be careful to install the knock sensor in the
correct direction.
(b) Connect the knock sensor connector.
2.
INSTALL INTAKE MANIFOLD
(a) Install a new gasket to the cylinder head.
Engine
Rear
A093710E01
ES
A087585E01
(b) Install the intake manifold with the 3 bolts and 2
nuts.
Torque: 20 N*m (204 kgf*cm, 15 ft.*lbf)
(c) Install the No. 1 fuel vapor feed hose to the hose
clamp.
A087584E01
(d) Install the harness clamp bracket with the bolt.
Torque: 9.0 N*m (92 kgf*cm, 80 in.*lbf)
(e) Install the connector clamp.
(f) Install the 3 wire harness clamps.
A087583E01
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – KNOCK SENSOR
ES–461
(g) Connect the throttle position sensor connector.
(h) Connect the throttle control motor connector.
A087575E01
(i)
(j)
Connect the No. 2 water by-pass hose.
Connect the water by-pass hose.
A087574E01
(k) Connect the No. 1 fuel vapor feed hose.
(l) Connect the No. 2 ventilation hose.
(m) Connect the ventilation hose.
A087573E01
3.
INSTALL OIL DIPSTICK GUIDE
(a) Apply a light coat of engine oil to a new O-ring and
install it to the dipstick guide.
New O-Ring
A087556E02
(b) Install the dipstick guide with the bolt.
Torque: 9.0 N*m (92 kgf*cm, 80 in.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Be careful that the O-ring is not cracked or
jammed when installing it.
(c) Connect the wire harness clamp.
(d) Install the dipstick.
4.
A087582E01
INSTALL AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY (See page ES453)
ES
ES–462
ES
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – KNOCK SENSOR
5.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
6.
ADD ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-7)
7.
CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS (See page
CO-2)
8.
INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
9.
INSTALL RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
(See page ES-454)
10. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – EFI RELAY
ES–463
EFI RELAY
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY (UNIT B: EFI RELAY
M RELAY)
NOTICE:
• The EFI relay is built into the integration relay
(unit B: EFI MAIN).
• Some relays are built into the integration relay.
The integration relay cannot be disassembled. If
there is a malfunction in the circuit of the
integration relay, replace the integration relay.
(a) Using a screwdriver, detach the 2 claws and
disconnect the integration relay from the engine
room No. 1 junction block.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Disconnect the 3 connectors from the integration
relay.
A135397
(c) Measure the resistance between the terminals.
Standard resistance
3I
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3I-5 - 3I-8
10 kΩ or higher
3I-5 - 3I-8
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to
terminals 3I-6 and 3I-7)
If the result is not as specified, replace the
integration relay.
(d) Connect the 3 connectors to the integration relay.
(e) Install the integration relay to the engine room No. 1
junction block.
3I
5
8
6
7
A114366E01
3.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
4.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain system need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
ES
ES–464
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY
CIRCUIT OPENING RELAY
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY (UNIT C: C/OPN
RELAY)
NOTICE:
• The EFI relay is built into the integration relay
(unit C: C/OPN RELAY).
• Some relays are built into the integration relay.
The integration relay cannot be disassembled. If
there is a malfunction in the circuit of the
integration relay, replace the integration relay.
ES
(a) Using a screwdriver, detach the 2 claws and
disconnect the integration relay from the No. 1
engine room junction block.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Disconnect the 2 connectors from the integration
relay.
A135397
(c) Measure the resistance between the terminals.
Standard resistance
3G
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3G-5 - 3G-8
10 kΩ or higher
3G-5 - 3G-8
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to
terminals 3G-6 and 3G-7)
If the result is not as specified, replace the
integration relay.
(d) Connect the 2 connectors to the integration relay.
(e) Install the integration relay to the engine room No. 1
junction block.
3G
5
8
6
7
A114366E02
3.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
4.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain system need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
ES–465
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – ECM
ECM
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL SPEAKER PANEL
SUB-ASSEMBLY (w/ JBL Sound System)
FRONT PILLAR GARNISH RH
ES
FRONT PILLAR GARNISH LH
FRONT PILLAR GARNISH CORNER PIECE RH
FRONT PILLAR GARNISH CORNER PIECE LH
20 (204, 15)
INSTRUMENT PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
CLOCK ASSEMBLY
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL END
MULTI-DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B126622E02
ES–466
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – ECM
UPPER INSTRUMENT PANEL
FINISH PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
INSTRUMENT PANEL HOLE COVER
INSTRUMENT PANEL HOLE COVER
ES
GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR
NO. 2 INSTRUMENT PANEL
REGISTER ASSEMBLY
NO. 4 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY
NO. 3 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY
INSTRUMENT PANEL CUSHION
NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL
REGISTER ASSEMBLY
GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR STOPPER SUB-ASSEMBLY
LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR ASSEMBLY
B126623E03
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – ECM
ES–467
ES
NO. 3 HEATER TO REGISTER DUCT
ECM WITH HYBRID VEHICLE
CONTROL ECU
A112299E02
ES–468
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – ECM
NO. 1 ECM BRACKET
3.0 (31, 27 in.*lbf)
ECM
3.0 (31, 27 in.*lbf)
ES
NO. 1 ECM BRACKET
3.0 (31, 27 in.*lbf)
3.0 (31, 27 in.*lbf)
NO. 2 ECM BRACKET
NO. 3 ECM BRACKET
3.0 (31, 27 in.*lbf)
NO. 1 ECM BRACKET
NO. 2 ECM BRACKET
HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A112300E01
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – ECM
ES–469
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the instrument panel (see page IP-5).
3.
REMOVE NO. 3 HEATER TO REGISTER DUCT (See
page AC-147)
4.
REMOVE ECM
(a) Disconnect the 4 ECM connectors.
(b) Disconnect the 4 hybrid vehicle control ECU
connectors.
A087532E01
(c) Remove the 2 nuts and bolt, and ECM with bracket.
A087535E01
(d) Remove the 2 nuts and ECM.
A087475E01
ES
ES–470
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – ECM
(e) Remove the 6 screws and 3 No. 1 ECM brackets.
A087476E01
(f)
Remove the 4 screws and 2 No. 2 ECM brackets.
ES
A087477E01
(g) Remove the 2 screws and No. 3 ECM bracket.
A087478E01
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL ECM
(a) Install the No. 3 ECM bracket with the 2 screws.
A087478E01
(b) Install the 2 No. 2 ECM brackets with the 4 screws.
A087477E01
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM – ECM
ES–471
(c) Install the 3 No. 1 ECM brackets with the 6 screws.
A087476E01
(d) Install the ECM with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 3.0 N*m (31 kgf*cm, 27 in.*lbf)
A087475E01
(e) Install the ECM with bracket with the 2 nuts and bolt.
Torque: 3.0 N*m (31 kgf*cm, 27 in.*lbf)
A087535E01
(f)
Connect the 4 hybrid vehicle control ECU
connectors.
(g) Connect the 4 ECM connectors.
2.
INSTALL NO. 3 HEATER TO REGISTER DUCT (See
page AC-159)
3.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the instrument panel (see page IP-11).
4.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
5.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
A087532E01
ES
ET–1
EXTERIOR – FRONT BUMPER
FRONT BUMPER
EXTERIOR
BODY
COMPONENTS
FRONT BUMPER
SIDE SUPPORT RH
FRONT FENDER LINER RH
FRONT BUMPER
SIDE SUPPORT LH
FRONT BUMPER
ENERGY ABSORBER
67 (683, 49)
FRONT FENDER LINER LH
FRONT BUMPER REINFORCEMENT
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
RADIATOR GRILLE PROTECTOR
FRONT BUMPER COVER
ET
CENTER NO. 4 ENGINE UNDER COVER
FRONT SPOILER COVER
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B130311E04
ET–2
EXTERIOR – FRONT BUMPER
RADIATOR GRILLE
FRONT BUMPER MOULDING
FRONT BUMPER COVER
FRONT BUMPER EXTENSION
MOUNTING BRACKET
LOWER RADIATOR
GRILLE RH
FRONT TURN SIGNAL LIGHT
MOUNTING BRACKET RH
ET
LOWER RADIATOR GRILLE LH
FOG LIGHT UNIT RH
(w/ Fog Light)
FOG LIGHT UNIT LH
(w/ Fog Light)
B130313E03
EXTERIOR – FRONT BUMPER
ET–3
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE FRONT FENDER LINER LH
(a) Using a clip remover, remove the clip.
(b) Partially remove the fender liner.
HINT:
It is not necessary to fully remove the fender liner.
Partially remove it so that the bumper cover can be
removed in a later step.
3.
REMOVE FRONT FENDER LINER RH
HINT:
Use the same procedure described for the LH side.
4.
REMOVE CENTER NO. 4 ENGINE UNDER COVER
(a) Remove the 5 screws, 4 bolts and under cover.
5.
REMOVE FRONT SPOILER COVER
(a) Remove the 7 screws and spoiler cover.
B130315
B130318
B130317
ET
ET–4
EXTERIOR – FRONT BUMPER
Radiator Grille Protector
6.
REMOVE FRONT BUMPER COVER
(a) Put protective tape under the front fender.
(b) Using a clip remover, remove the 3 clips.
(c) Remove the 2 radiator grille protectors and 4
screws.
(d) Detach the 8 claws.
Protective Tape
B130316E01
(e) Detach the 4 claws and remove the bumper cover.
(1) Hold the front bumper cover on its upper and
lower parts with your hands as shown in the
illustration.
(2) Pull up the front bumper cover's lower part
while holding its upper part securely.
NOTICE:
• The claw will not disengage unless the
front bumper cover's upper part is
securely held.
• Do not forcibly pull up the front bumper.
This will deform the claw.
(f) w/ Fog light:
Disconnect the 2 fog light connectors.
Protective Tape
B078079E02
ET
7.
REMOVE FRONT BUMPER ENERGY ABSORBER
8.
REMOVE FRONT BUMPER REINFORCEMENT
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the 4 wire harness
clamps.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Remove the 4 nuts and reinforcement.
9.
REMOVE FRONT BUMPER SIDE SUPPORT LH
(a) Remove the 2 screws and side support.
10. REMOVE FRONT BUMPER SIDE SUPPORT RH
(a) Remove the 2 screws and side support.
DISASSEMBLY
1.
B073580E01
REMOVE FRONT BUMPER MOULDING
(a) Remove the 4 screws.
(b) Using a screwdriver, detach the 4 claws and remove
the moulding.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
EXTERIOR – FRONT BUMPER
B073577E01
ET–5
2.
REMOVE LOWER RADIATOR GRILLE LH
(a) Using a screwdriver, detach the 4 claws and remove
the grille.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
3.
REMOVE LOWER RADIATOR GRILLE RH
HINT:
Use the same procedure described for the LH side.
4.
REMOVE FOG LIGHT UNIT LH (w/ Fog Light) (See
page LI-87)
5.
REMOVE FOG LIGHT UNIT RH (w/ Fog Light)
HINT:
Use the same procedure described for the LH side.
6.
REMOVE RADIATOR GRILLE
(a) Using a screwdriver, detach the 12 claws and
remove the grille.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
7.
REMOVE FRONT TURN SIGNAL LIGHT MOUNTING
BRACKET RH
(a) Using a screwdriver, detach the claws and remove
the mounting bracket.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
8.
REMOVE FRONT BUMPER EXTENSION MOUNTING
BRACKET
(a) Remove the 2 screws and mounting bracket.
B073578E03
ET
ET–6
EXTERIOR – FRONT BUMPER
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL FRONT BUMPER EXTENSION MOUNTING
BRACKET
(a) Install the mounting bracket with the 2 screws.
2.
INSTALL FRONT TURN SIGNAL LIGHT MOUNTING
BRACKET RH
(a) Attach the claws to install the mounting bracket.
3.
INSTALL RADIATOR GRILLE
(a) Attach the 12 claws to install the grille.
4.
INSTALL FOG LIGHT UNIT LH (w/ Fog Light) (See
page LI-88)
5.
INSTALL FOG LIGHT UNIT RH (w/ Fog Light)
HINT:
Use the same procedure described for the LH side.
6.
INSTALL LOWER RADIATOR GRILLE LH
(a) Attach the 4 claws to install the grille.
7.
INSTALL LOWER RADIATOR GRILLE RH
HINT:
Use the same procedure described for the LH side.
8.
INSTALL FRONT BUMPER MOULDING
(a) Attach the 4 claws to install the moulding.
B073578E03
B073577E01
(b) Install the 4 screws.
B073580E01
ET
EXTERIOR – FRONT BUMPER
ET–7
INSTALLATION
HINT:
A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the standard
bolt chart (see page SS-2).
1.
INSTALL FRONT BUMPER SIDE SUPPORT LH
(a) Install the side support with 2 screws.
2.
INSTALL FRONT BUMPER SIDE SUPPORT RH
(a) Install the side support with 2 screws.
3.
INSTALL FRONT BUMPER REINFORCEMENT
(a) Install the reinforcement with the 4 nuts.
Torque: 67 N*m (683 kgf*cm, 49 ft.*lbf)
(b) Install the 4 wire harness clamps.
4.
INSTALL FRONT BUMPER ENERGY ABSORBER
5.
INSTALL FRONT BUMPER COVER
(a) Put protective tape under the front fender.
(b) w/ Fog light:
Connect the 2 fog light connectors.
(c) Attach the 12 claws to install the bumper cover.
(d) Install the 4 screws and 3 clips.
(e) Install the 2 radiator grille protectors.
Torque: 5.0 N*m (51 kgf*cm, 44 in.*lbf)
6.
INSTALL FRONT SPOILER COVER
(a) Install the spoiler cover with the 7 screws.
Radiator Grille Protector
Protective Tape
B132997E01
ET
B130317
7.
B130318
INSTALL CENTER NO. 4 ENGINE UNDER COVER
(a) Install the under cover with the 5 screws and 4 bolts.
ET–8
EXTERIOR – FRONT BUMPER
8.
INSTALL FRONT FENDER LINER LH
(a) Install the fender liner with the clip.
9.
INSTALL FRONT FENDER LINER RH
HINT:
Use the same procedure described for the LH side.
10. CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
B130315
ET
11. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
ET–8
EXTERIOR – REAR BUMPER
REAR BUMPER
EXTERIOR
BODY
COMPONENTS
REAR BUMPER REINFORCEMENT
SUB-ASSEMBLY
REAR BUMPER ARM
SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
REAR BUMPER SIDE
RETAINER RH
REAR BUMPER ARM SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
REAR BUMPER CENTER BRACKET
REAR BUMPER ENERGY ABSORBER
REAR BUMPER SIDE
RETAINER LH
REAR BUMPER COVER
STOPPER
ET
REAR NO. 1 SPOILER
REAR SIDE
SPOILER RH
REAR SIDE SPOILER LH
B132594E01
ET–9
EXTERIOR – REAR BUMPER
REMOVAL
HINT:
When replacing the spoiler, heat the bumper cover and
spoiler using a heat light.
Standard heating temperature
Item
Specified Condition
Spoiler
40 to 60°C (104 to 140°F)
Bumper cover
20 to 30°C (68 to 86°F)
NOTICE:
Do not heat the bumper cover and spoiler excessively.
1.
Protective Tape
REMOVE REAR BUMPER COVER
(a) Put protective tape under the quarter panel.
(b) Remove the 5 screws, nut and 2 stoppers.
(c) Using a clip remover, remove the 4 clips.
(d) Using a screwdriver, detach the 10 claws.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
B088175E03
(e) Detach the 2 claws and remove the bumper cover.
(1) Hold the rear bumper cover on its upper and
lower parts with your hands as shown in the
illustration.
(2) Pull up the rear bumper cover's lower part while
holding its upper part securely.
NOTICE:
• The claw will not detach unless the rear
bumper cover's upper part is securely
held.
• Do not forcibly pull up the rear bumper.
This will deform the claw.
B088176E02
2.
REMOVE REAR SIDE SPOILER LH
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the 2 retainers.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Remove the 2 clips and 3 screws.
ET
B078273E01
ET–10
EXTERIOR – REAR BUMPER
(c) Put protective tape under the rear bumper cover.
(d) Using a heat light, heat the spoiler.
NOTICE:
Do not heat the spoiler excessively.
(e) Cut the double-sided tape that holds the spoiler to
the bumper cover with a knife.
NOTICE:
• If reusing the spoiler, take care not to damage
the spoiler.
• Be careful not to damage the bumper cover.
(f) Remove the spoiler.
Protective Tape
Double-sided Tape
B079593E01
3.
REMOVE REAR SIDE SPOILER RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
4.
REMOVE REAR NO. 1 SPOILER
(a) Using a clip remover, remove the 5 clips.
B078276E01
(b) Put protective tape under the rear bumper cover.
(c) Using a heat light, heat the spoiler.
NOTICE:
Do not heat the spoiler excessively.
(d) Cut the double-sided tape that holds the spoiler to
the bumper cover with a knife.
NOTICE:
• If reusing the spoiler, take care not to damage
the spoiler.
• Be careful not to damage the bumper cover.
(e) Remove the spoiler.
Protective Tape
Double-sided Tape
B079449E01
ET
5.
REMOVE REAR BUMPER ENERGY ABSORBER
6.
REMOVE REAR BUMPER CENTER BRACKET
7.
REMOVE REAR BUMPER REINFORCEMENT SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 4 nuts and reinforcement.
8.
REMOVE REAR BUMPER ARM SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and bumper arm.
9.
REMOVE REAR BUMPER ARM SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and bumper arm.
10. REMOVE REAR BUMPER SIDE RETAINER LH
(a) Remove the 2 screws and side retainer.
11. REMOVE REAR BUMPER SIDE RETAINER RH
(a) Remove the 2 screws and side retainer.
ET–11
EXTERIOR – REAR BUMPER
INSTALLATION
HINT:
• A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the
standard bolt chart (see page SS-2).
• When installing the spoiler, heat the bumper cover and
spoiler using a heat light.
Standard heating temperature
Item
Specified Condition
Spoiler
40 to 60°C (104 to 140°F)
Bumper cover
20 to 30°C (68 to 86°F)
NOTICE:
Do not heat the bumper cover and spoiler excessively.
1.
INSTALL REAR BUMPER SIDE RETAINER LH
(a) Install the side retainer with the 2 screws.
2.
INSTALL REAR BUMPER SIDE RETAINER RH
(a) Install the side retainer with the 2 screws.
3.
INSTALL REAR BUMPER ARM SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the bumper arm with the 2 bolts.
4.
INSTALL REAR BUMPER ARM SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Install the bumper arm with the 2 bolts.
5.
INSTALL REAR BUMPER REINFORCEMENT SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Install the reinforcement with the 4 nuts.
6.
INSTALL REAR BUMPER CENTER BRACKET
7.
INSTALL REAR BUMPER ENERGY ABSORBER
8.
INSTALL REAR NO. 1 SPOILER
(a) Clean the bumper cover surface.
(1) Using a heat light, heat the bumper cover.
NOTICE:
Do not heat the bumper cover excessively.
(2) Remove the double-sided tape from the
bumper cover.
(3) Wipe off any tape adhesive residue with white
gasoline.
(b) If reusing the spoiler:
Clean the spoiler and install new double-sided tape.
(1) Using a heat light, heat the spoiler.
NOTICE:
Do not heat the spoiler excessively.
(2) Remove the double-sided tape from the spoiler.
(3) Wipe off any tape adhesive residue with white
gasoline.
(4) Install new double-sided tape to the spoiler.
NOTICE:
Install the double-sided tape exactly
according to the specifications below.
ET
ET–12
EXTERIOR – REAR BUMPER
0.8 mm
(0.031 in.)
A
Double-sided Tape
4.0 mm (0.157 in.)
A
A-A
B079450E03
(c) Install the spoiler.
(1) Using a heat light, heat the bumper cover and
spoiler.
NOTICE:
Do not heat the bumper cover and spoiler
excessively.
(2) Remove the peeling paper from the face of the
spoiler.
NOTICE:
After removing the peeling paper, keep the
exposed adhesive free from foreign matter.
(3) Install the spoiler with the 5 clips.
NOTICE:
Do not apply excessive force to the spoiler.
Apply steady pressure with your thumbs.
9.
ET
INSTALL REAR SIDE SPOILER LH
(a) Clean the bumper cover surface.
(1) Using a heat light, heat the bumper cover.
NOTICE:
Do not heat the bumper cover excessively.
(2) Remove the double-sided tape from the
bumper cover.
(3) Wipe off any tape adhesive residue with white
gasoline.
(b) If reusing the spoiler:
Clean the spoiler and install new double-sided tape.
(1) Using a heat light, heat the spoiler.
NOTICE:
Do not heat the spoiler excessively.
(2) Remove the double-sided tape from the spoiler.
(3) Wipe off any tape adhesive residue with white
gasoline.
(4) Install new double-sided tape to the spoiler.
NOTICE:
Install the double-sided tape exactly
according to the specifications below.
ET–13
EXTERIOR – REAR BUMPER
50.0 mm
(1.969 in.)
100.0 mm
(3.937 in.)
150.0 mm
(5.906 in.)
0.8 mm
(0.031 in.)
A
Double-sided Tape
A
4.0 mm
(0.157 in.)
Double-sided Tape
A-A
B079451E03
(c) Install the spoiler.
(1) Using a heat light, heat the bumper cover and
spoiler.
NOTICE:
Do not heat the bumper cover and spoiler
excessively.
(2) Remove the peeling paper from the face of the
spoiler.
NOTICE:
After removing the peeling paper, keep the
exposed adhesive free from foreign matter.
(3) Install the spoiler with the 2 retainers, 2 clips
and 3 screws.
NOTICE:
Do not apply excessive force to the spoiler.
Apply steady pressure with your thumbs.
10. INSTALL REAR SIDE SPOILER RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the LH side.
B078273E01
11. REMOVE REAR BUMPER COVER
(a) Put protective tape under the quarter panel.
(b) Attach the 12 claws to install the bumper cover.
(c) Install the 4 clips, 5 screws, nut and 2 stoppers.
Protective Tape
B132595E01
ET
ET–14
EXTERIOR – NAME PLATE
NAME PLATE
REPLACEMENT
1.
INSTALL NAME PLATE
1
2
3
Body R End
R End
1
B
A
C
D
Body R End
K
2
ET
E
L
3
F
H
G
J
I
B076801E03
ET–15
EXTERIOR – NAME PLATE
Standard measurement
Area
Specified Condition
Area
Specified Condition
A
74.1 mm (2.917 in.)
G
66.2 mm (2.606 in.)
B
48.6 mm (1.913 in.)
H
32.0 mm (1.620 in.)
C
114.0 mm (4.488 in.)
I
99.6 mm (3.921 in.)
D
89.1 mm (3.508 in.)
J
36.2 mm (1.425 in.)
E
61.0 mm (2.402 in.)
K
36.9 mm (1.453 in.)
F
115.1 mm (4.531 in.)
L
64.5 mm (2.540 in.)
ET
ET–16
EXTERIOR – REAR SPOILER
REAR SPOILER
EXTERIOR
BODY
COMPONENTS
REAR SPOILER SUB-ASSEMBLY
BACK DOOR UPPER TRIM
BOARD ASSEMBLY
CENTER STOP
LIGHT ASSEMBLY
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
BACK DOOR LOWER TRIM
BOARD ASSEMBLY
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
REAR WIPER MOTOR
ASSEMBLY
ET
REAR WIPER ARM ASSEMBLY
REAR WIPER MOTOR GROMMET
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B132618E03
EXTERIOR – REAR SPOILER
ET–17
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE REAR WIPER ARM ASSEMBLY (See page
WW-22)
3.
REMOVE BACK DOOR LOWER TRIM BOARD
ASSEMBLY (See page ED-43)
4.
REMOVE BACK DOOR UPPER TRIM BOARD
ASSEMBLY (See page ED-44)
5.
REMOVE REAR WIPER MOTOR ASSEMBLY (See
page WW-22)
6.
REMOVE REAR SPOILER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Put protective tape under the rear spoiler.
(b) Remove the 4 bolts.
(c) Using a screwdriver, detach the 3 clips and remove
the rear spoiler.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(d) Disconnect the center stop light connector.
7.
REMOVE CENTER STOP LIGHT ASSEMBLY (See
page LI-94)
Protective Tape
B076775E01
ET
ET–18
EXTERIOR – REAR SPOILER
INSTALLATION
Protective Tape
1.
INSTALL CENTER STOP LIGHT ASSEMBLY (See
page LI-94)
2.
INSTALL REAR SPOILER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Put protective tape under the rear spoiler.
(b) Connect the center stop light connector.
(c) Attach the 3 clips to install the rear spoiler.
(d) Install the 4 bolts.
3.
INSTALL REAR WIPER MOTOR ASSEMBLY (See
page WW-22)
4.
INSTALL BACK DOOR UPPER TRIM BOARD
ASSEMBLY (See page ED-48)
5.
INSTALL BACK DOOR LOWER TRIM BOARD
ASSEMBLY (See page ED-48)
6.
INSTALL REAR WIPER ARM ASSEMBLY (See page
WW-23)
7.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
8.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
B076775E02
ET
ET–19
EXTERIOR – FRONT DOOR BELT MOULDING
FRONT DOOR BELT MOULDING
EXTERIOR
BODY
COMPONENTS
OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR
ASSEMBLY LH
FRONT DOOR BELT MOULDING
ASSEMBLY LH
DOOR PULL HANDLE
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
FRONT DOOR LOWER FRAME
BRACKET GARNISH LH
FRONT DOOR INSIDE
HANDLE BEZEL LH
FRONT DOOR TRIM BOARD
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
ET
FRONT ARMREST
UPPER BASE PANEL LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B132610E02
ET–20
EXTERIOR – FRONT DOOR BELT MOULDING
REMOVAL
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
Protective Tape
ET
Moulding Remover
B074194E02
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR LOWER FRAME BRACKET
GARNISH LH (See page ED-11)
3.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR INSIDE HANDLE BEZEL LH
(See page ED-11)
4.
REMOVE DOOR PULL HANDLE (See page ED-11)
5.
REMOVE FRONT ARMREST UPPER BASE PANEL
LH (See page ED-11)
6.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR TRIM BOARD SUBASSEMBLY LH (See page ED-12)
7.
REMOVE OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSEMBLY
LH (See page MI-9)
8.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR BELT MOULDING
ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Put protective tape under the moulding.
(b) Using a moulding remover, detach the claws to
remove the moulding as shown in the illustration.
HINT:
Tape the remover tip before use.
EXTERIOR – FRONT DOOR BELT MOULDING
ET–21
INSTALLATION
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR BELT MOULDING
ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Attach the claws to install the moulding.
HINT:
Confirm that the moulding is firmly installed.
2.
INSTALL OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSEMBLY
LH (See page MI-13)
3.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR TRIM BOARD SUBASSEMBLY LH (See page ED-21)
4.
INSTALL FRONT ARMREST UPPER BASE PANEL LH
(See page ED-21)
5.
INSTALL DOOR PULL HANDLE (See page ED-22)
6.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR INSIDE HANDLE BEZEL LH
(See page ED-22)
7.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR LOWER FRAME BRACKET
GARNISH LH (See page ED-22)
8.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
9.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
B132614
ET
ET–22
EXTERIOR – REAR DOOR BELT MOULDING
REAR DOOR BELT MOULDING
EXTERIOR
BODY
COMPONENTS
DOOR PULL HANDLE
REAR DOOR BELT
MOULDING ASSEMBLY LH
REAR DOOR TRIM BOARD
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
ET
REAR DOOR ARMREST
UPPER BASE PANEL LH
REAR DOOR INSIDE
HANDLE BEZEL LH
B132612E02
EXTERIOR – REAR DOOR BELT MOULDING
ET–23
REMOVAL
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE REAR DOOR INSIDE HANDLE BEZEL LH
(See page ED-28)
3.
REMOVE DOOR PULL HANDLE (See page ED-28)
4.
REMOVE REAR DOOR ARMREST UPPER BASE
PANEL LH (See page ED-28)
5.
REMOVE REAR DOOR TRIM BOARD SUBASSEMBLY LH (See page ED-28)
6.
REMOVE REAR DOOR BELT MOULDING ASSEMBLY
LH
(a) Put protective tape under the moulding.
(b) Using a moulding remover, detach the claws to
remove the moulding as shown in the illustration.
HINT:
Tape the remover tip before use.
Protective Tape
Moulding Remover
B074179E02
ET
ET–24
EXTERIOR – REAR DOOR BELT MOULDING
INSTALLATION
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
INSTALL REAR DOOR BELT MOULDING ASSEMBLY
LH
(a) Attach the claws to install the moulding.
HINT:
Confirm that the moulding is firmly installed.
2.
INSTALL REAR DOOR TRIM BOARD SUBASSEMBLY LH (See page ED-37)
3.
INSTALL REAR DOOR ARMREST UPPER BASE
PANEL LH (See page ED-37)
4.
INSTALL DOOR PULL HANDLE (See page ED-37)
5.
INSTALL REAR DOOR INSIDE HANDLE BEZEL LH
(See page ED-37)
6.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
7.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
B132613
ET
EXTERIOR – ROOF DRIP SIDE FINISH MOULDING
ET–25
ROOF DRIP SIDE FINISH MOULDING
EXTERIOR
BODY
COMPONENTS
ROOF DRIP SIDE FINISH MOULDING LH
ROOF DRIP
SIDE FINISH
MOULDING CLIP
ROOF DRIP SIDE FINISH
MOULDING CLIP
Non-reusable part
B132616E04
ET
ET–26
EXTERIOR – ROOF DRIP SIDE FINISH MOULDING
REMOVAL
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
Protective Tape
B074186E02
ET
REMOVE ROOF DRIP SIDE FINISH MOULDING LH
(a) Put protective tape around the edges of the
moulding.
(b) Using a moulding remover, detach the moulding's
front and rear end 2 clips and remove the moulding.
NOTICE:
• Do not remove the clips from the vehicle
body.
• If the clips are damaged or removed
accidentally, replace them.
EXTERIOR – ROOF DRIP SIDE FINISH MOULDING
ET–27
INSTALLATION
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
• When replacing the clip, heat the vehicle body and clip
using a heat light.
Standard heating temperature
Item
Specified Condition
Vehicle body
40 to 60°C (104 to 140°F)
Clip
20 to 30°C (68 to 86°F)
NOTICE:
Do not heat the clip and vehicle body excessively.
1.
Front
REPLACE ROOF DRIP SIDE FINISH MOULDING CLIP
HINT:
Use the procedures below to replace damaged or
accidentally removed clips. If this step is not necessary,
go to the next step.
NOTICE:
After press-fitting the clips, wait 30 minutes or more
before installing the moulding.
HINT:
• Minimum hardening time: 30 minutes
• Time needed for complete hardening: 24 hours
(a) Remove the double-sided tape that remains on the
surfaces of the moulding and vehicle body, and then
clean the surface with white gasoline.
(b) Using a heat light, heat the clip installation surface
of the vehicle body and installation part of the clips.
(c) Install new clips to the positions shown in the
illustration. Press-fit the clips by hand.
Clip
1.6 mm
(0.063 in.)
R end
Rear
ET
Clip
9.2 mm
(0.362 in.)
R end
mm (in.)
B076907E02
ET–28
EXTERIOR – ROOF DRIP SIDE FINISH MOULDING
2.
Protective Tape
B074186E02
ET
INSTALL ROOF DRIP SIDE FINISH MOULDING LH
(a) Put protective tape around the edges of the
moulding.
(b) Adjust the position of the moulding so that the front
and rear ends attach to the vehicle's 2 clips, and
install the moulding.
(c) Remove the protective tape.
ET–28
EXTERIOR – SIDE MUDGUARD
SIDE MUDGUARD
EXTERIOR
BODY
COMPONENTS
SIDE MUDGUARD LH
ET
RETAINER
REAR WHEEL HOUSE
FRONT PLATE LH
B132596E05
EXTERIOR – SIDE MUDGUARD
ET–29
REMOVAL
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the LH side and RH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL HOUSE FRONT PLATE LH
(a) Remove the screw and front plate.
2.
REMOVE SIDE MUDGUARD LH
(a) Remove the screw and 8 retainers.
(b) Detach the clip and remove the mudguard.
B074189E01
B074190E02
ET
ET–30
EXTERIOR – SIDE MUDGUARD
INSTALLATION
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the LH side and RH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
INSTALL SIDE MUDGUARD LH
(a) Attach the clip to install the mudguard.
(b) Install the screw and 8 retainers.
B074190E02
2.
B074189E01
ET
INSTALL REAR WHEEL HOUSE FRONT PLATE LH
(a) Install the front plate with the screw.
EXTERIOR – FRONT DOOR WINDOW FRAME MOULDING
ET–31
FRONT DOOR WINDOW FRAME MOULDING
EXTERIOR
BODY
COMPONENTS
FRONT DOOR WINDOW FRAME
REAR MOULDING LH
B132609E02
ET
ET–32
EXTERIOR – FRONT DOOR WINDOW FRAME MOULDING
REMOVAL
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
• When removing the moulding, heat the vehicle body and
moulding using a heat light.
Standard heating temperature
Item
Specified Condition
Vehicle Body
40 to 60°C (104 to 140°F)
Moulding
20 to 30°C (68 to 86°F)
NOTICE:
Do not heat the vehicle body and moulding excessively.
1.
Double-sided Tape
B074180E02
ET
REMOVE FRONT DOOR WINDOW FRAME REAR
MOULDING LH
(a) Remove the screw.
(b) Using a heat light, heat the moulding and vehicle
body.
(c) Cut the double-sided tape that holds the moulding to
the vehicle body with a knife.
NOTICE:
• If reusing the moulding, take care not to
damage the moulding.
• Be careful not to damage the vehicle body.
(d) Remove the moulding.
EXTERIOR – FRONT DOOR WINDOW FRAME MOULDING
ET–33
INSTALLATION
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
• When installing the moulding, heat the vehicle body and
moulding using a heat light.
Standard heating temperature
Item
Specified Condition
Vehicle Body
40 to 60°C (104 to 140°F)
Moulding
20 to 30°C (68 to 86°F)
NOTICE:
Do not heat the vehicle body and moulding excessively.
1.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR WINDOW FRAME REAR
MOULDING LH
(a) Clean the vehicle body surface.
(1) Using a heat light, heat the vehicle body.
(2) Remove the double-sided tape from the vehicle
body.
(3) Wipe off any tape adhesive residue with white
gasoline.
(b) If reusing the moulding:
Clean the moulding and install new double-sided
tape.
(1) Using a heat light, heat the moulding.
(2) Remove the double-sided tape from the
moulding.
(3) Wipe off any tape adhesive residue with white
gasoline.
(4) Install new double-sided tape to the moulding.
NOTICE:
Install the double-sided tape exactly
according to the specifications below.
Standard measurement
(2)
(1)
A
B
C
B074182E03
Area
Specified Condition
A
(1) 440.0 mm (17.323 in.)
(2) 37.0 mm (1.457 in.)
B
5.0 mm (0.197 in.)
C
0.8 mm (0.032 in.)
(c) Install the moulding.
(1) Using a heat light, heat the vehicle body and
moulding.
(2) Remove the peeling paper from the face of the
moulding.
NOTICE:
After removing the peeling paper, keep the
exposed adhesive free from foreign matter.
(3) Install the moulding with the screw.
NOTICE:
Do not apply excessive force to the
moulding. Apply steady pressure with your
thumbs.
ET
ET–34
EXTERIOR – REAR DOOR WINDOW FRAME MOULDING
REAR DOOR WINDOW FRAME MOULDING
EXTERIOR
BODY
COMPONENTS
REAR DOOR WINDOW FRAME
FRONT MOULDING LH
B132611E02
ET
EXTERIOR – REAR DOOR WINDOW FRAME MOULDING
ET–35
REMOVAL
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
• When removing the moulding, heat the vehicle body and
moulding using a heat light.
Standard heating temperature
Item
Specified Condition
Vehicle Body
40 to 60°C (104 to 140°F)
Moulding
20 to 30°C (68 to 86°F)
NOTICE:
Do not heat the vehicle body and moulding excessively.
1.
Double-sided Tape
B074181E02
REMOVE REAR DOOR WINDOW FRAME FRONT
MOULDING LH
(a) Remove the screw.
(b) Using a heat light, heat the moulding and vehicle
body.
(c) Cut the double-sided tape that holds the moulding to
the vehicle body with a knife.
NOTICE:
• If reusing the moulding, take care not to
damage the moulding.
• Be careful not to damage the vehicle body.
(d) Remove the moulding.
ET
ET–36
EXTERIOR – REAR DOOR WINDOW FRAME MOULDING
INSTALLATION
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
• When installing the moulding, heat the vehicle body and
moulding using a heat light.
Standard heating temperature
Item
Specified Condition
Vehicle Body
40 to 60°C (104 to 140°F)
Moulding
20 to 30°C (68 to 86°F)
NOTICE:
Do not heat the vehicle body and moulding excessively.
1.
(4) Install new double-sided tape to the moulding.
NOTICE:
Install the double-sided tape exactly
according to the specifications below.
Standard measurement
(2)
(1)
INSTALL REAR DOOR WINDOW FRAME FRONT
MOULDING LH
(a) Clean the vehicle body surface.
(1) Using a heat light, heat the vehicle body.
(2) Remove the double-sided tape from the vehicle
body.
(3) Wipe off any tape adhesive residue with white
gasoline.
(b) If reusing the moulding:
Clean the moulding and install new double-sided
tape.
(1) Using a heat light, heat the moulding.
(2) Remove the double-sided tape from the
moulding.
(3) Wipe off any tape adhesive residue with white
gasoline.
Area
Specified Condition
A
(1) 360.0 mm (14.173 in.)
(2) 37.0 mm (1.457 in.)
(3) 440.0 mm (17.322 in.)
B
5.0 mm (0.197 in.)
C
(1) 1.2 mm (0.047 in.)
(2) 0.8 mm (0.032 in.)
(3) 0.8 mm (0.032 in.)
(3)
ET
A
B
C
B074183E03
(c) Install the moulding.
(1) Using a heat light, heat the vehicle body and
moulding.
(2) Remove the peeling paper from the face of the
moulding.
NOTICE:
After removing the peeling paper, keep the
exposed adhesive free from foreign matter.
EXTERIOR – REAR DOOR WINDOW FRAME MOULDING
ET–37
(3) Install the moulding with the screw.
NOTICE:
Do not apply excessive force to the
moulding. Apply steady pressure with your
thumbs.
ET
EXTERIOR – BACK DOOR OUTSIDE GARNISH
ET–37
BACK DOOR OUTSIDE GARNISH
EXTERIOR
BODY
COMPONENTS
BACK DOOR OUTSIDE GARNISH
BACK DOOR LOWER TRIM BOARD ASSEMBLY
BACK DOOR OPENER
SWITCH ASSEMBLY
B132615E03
ET
ET–38
EXTERIOR – BACK DOOR OUTSIDE GARNISH
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE BACK DOOR LOWER TRIM BOARD
ASSEMBLY (See page ED-48)
3.
REMOVE BACK DOOR OUTSIDE GARNISH
(a) Disconnect the back door opener switch connector.
(b) Remove the 4 nuts.
Nut
Nut
Nut
B133842E01
(c) Using a screwdriver, detach the 2 clips and remove
the garnish (with back door opener switch).
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(d) Remove the 2 screws and back door opener switch
from the garnish.
ET
B067629E01
ET–39
EXTERIOR – BACK DOOR OUTSIDE GARNISH
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL BACK DOOR OUTSIDE GARNISH
(a) Install the back door opener switch to the garnish
with the 2 screws.
(b) Attach the 2 clips to install the garnish.
B067629E01
Nut
Nut
Nut
B133842E01
(c) Install the 4 nuts.
(d) Connect the back door opener switch connector.
2.
INSTALL BACK DOOR LOWER TRIM BOARD
ASSEMBLY (See page ED-48)
3.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
4.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
ET
EX–1
1NZ-FXE EXHAUST – EXHAUST PIPE
EXHAUST PIPE
1NZ-FXE EXHAUST
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
CLIP
CLIP
INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL LOWER CENTER
POWER OUTLET CONNECTOR
COMPRESSION SPRING
EX
FRONT FLOOR CARPET ASSEMBLY
43 (440, 32)
GASKET
WIRING HARNESS CLAMP BRACKET
x2
HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR
x4
x2
30 (302, 22)
FRONT FLOOR PANEL BRACE
GASKET
43 (440, 32)
COMPRESSION SPRING
FRONT EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
TAILPIPE ASSEMBLY
Non-reusable part
A125445E01
EX–2
1NZ-FXE EXHAUST – EXHAUST PIPE
REMOVAL
EX
1.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
2.
REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-4)
3.
REMOVE REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
4.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
5.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL
LOWER CENTER (See page IP-18)
6.
REMOVE HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (See page EC50)
7.
REMOVE FRONT FLOOR PANEL BRACE
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and floor panel brace.
8.
REMOVE TAILPIPE ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and 2 compression springs.
(b) Remove the tailpipe from the 2 exhaust supports.
(c) Remove the gasket from the front exhaust pipe.
A086201
A086202E01
9.
REMOVE FRONT EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and 2 compression springs.
1NZ-FXE EXHAUST – EXHAUST PIPE
EX–3
(b) Remove the front exhaust pipe from the 2 exhaust
pipe supports.
(c) Remove the gasket from the exhaust manifold.
EX
A086203
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL FRONT EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a vernier caliper, measure the free length of
the compression spring.
Minimum length:
40.5 mm (1.594 in.)
If the length is less than the minimum, replace the
compression spring.
A111834
Wooden
Block
Gasket
A076194E04
(b) Using a plastic-faced hammer and wooden block,
tap in a new gasket until its surface is flush with the
exhaust manifold.
NOTICE:
• Tap in the gasket in the correct direction.
• Do not reuse the removed gasket.
• Do not push in the gasket while installing the
exhaust pipe.
(c) Connect the 2 exhaust pipe supports, and install the
exhaust pipe.
(d) Install the 2 compression springs and 2 bolts.
Torque: 43 N*m (438 kgf*cm, 32 ft.*lbf)
EX–4
1NZ-FXE EXHAUST – EXHAUST PIPE
2.
INSTALL TAILPIPE ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a vernier caliper, measure the free length of
the compression spring.
Minimum length:
38.5 mm (1.516 in.)
If the length is less than the minimum, replace the
compression spring.
A111834
(b) Install a new gasket to the front exhaust pipe.
NOTICE:
Do not reuse the gasket.
(c) Connect the 2 exhaust pipe supports, and install the
tail pipe.
(d) Install the 2 compression springs and 2 bolts.
Torque: 43 N*m (438 kgf*cm, 32 ft.*lbf)
New Gasket
EX
A078440E01
3.
INSTALL FRONT FLOOR PANEL BRACE
(a) Install the floor panel brace with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 30 N*m (302 kgf*cm, 22 ft.*lbf)
4.
INSTALL HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (See page EC51)
5.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL
LOWER CENTER (See page IP-21)
6.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
7.
CHECK FOR EXHAUST GAS LEAKS
If gas is leaking, tighten the problem areas to stop the
leak. Replace damaged parts as necessary.
8.
INSTALL REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
9.
INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-8)
A086201
10. INSTALL REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
11. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting the cable from the negative (-)
battery terminal.
1NZ-FXE FUEL – FUEL SYSTEM
FU–1
FUEL SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
1.
2.
A088352E01
PRECAUTION
(a) Before working on the fuel system, disconnect the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal.
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner
activation.
(b) Do not work on the fuel system near fire. Never
smoke while performing work.
(c) Keep rubber or leather parts away from gasoline.
DISCHARGE FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE
CAUTION:
• Before removing the fuel system parts, take
precautions to prevent gasoline spillage.
• As some pressure remains in the fuel line even
after taking precautions to prevent gasoline
spillage, use a shop rag to prevent gasoline from
spilling when disconnecting the fuel line.
(a) Set the vehicle to the "INSPECTION MODE1" (see
page IN-34).
(b) Disconnect the cable from negative (-) battery
terminal.
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner
activation.
(c) Remove the rear seat cushion (see page SE-15).
(d) Remove the rear floor service hole cover.
(e) Disconnect the fuel pump connector.
(f) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery
terminal.
(g) Start the engine.
(h) After the engine stops (rough idle), turn the power
switch OFF.
HINT:
DTC P0171 (system to lean) may be present.
(i) Crank the engine again, then check that the engine
does not start.
(j) Remove the fuel tank cap, then discharge the
pressure in the fuel tank completely.
(k) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal.
(l) Connect the fuel pump connector.
(m) Install the rear floor service hole cover.
(n) Install the rear seat cushion (see page SE-23).
(o) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery
terminal..
FU
FU–2
1NZ-FXE FUEL – FUEL SYSTEM
(p) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
3.
Plastic Bag
A088338E04
FU
CORRECT
INCORRECT
O-Ring
FUEL SYSTEM
(a) When disconnecting the high-pressure fuel line, a
large amount of gasoline will spill out. So take the
following precautions.
(1) Discharge the fuel system pressure (see step
DISCHARGE FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE).
(2) Disconnect the fuel pump tube.
(3) Drain the pressure remaining in the fuel pump
tube.
(4) Cover the disconnected fuel pump tube (fuel
tube joint and fuel tube connector) with a plastic
bag to prevent damage and intrusion of foreign
objects.
(b) Take the following precautions when removing and
installing the fuel injector.
(1) Do not reuse the O-ring.
(2) Do not damage a new O-ring when installing it to
the fuel injector.
(3) Before installing a new O-ring, apply spindle oil
or gasoline.
NOTICE:
Do not use engine oil, gear oil or brake oil.
INCORRECT
Fuel Delivery Pipe
A112283E02
Insulator
O-Ring
Fuel Delivery Pipe
A088333E02
(c) Install the fuel injector to the fuel delivery pipe and
cylinder head as illustrated.
NOTICE:
Apply spindle oil or gasoline to the contact
surface of the fuel delivery pipe and fuel injector
before installing the fuel injector.
1NZ-FXE FUEL – FUEL SYSTEM
Retainer
Pinch
Pull Out
FU–3
(d) Take the following precautions when removing the
fuel tube connector (Type A).
(1) Check the fuel tube connector and pipe for dirt
or mud before removing the fuel tube connector.
If they are dirty, wipe them off with a shop rag.
(2) Pinch the retainer as illustrated, then pull out the
fuel tube connector from the pipe.
Pinch
A088336E14
(3) If the fuel tube connector and pipe are stuck,
pinch the pipe, then push and pull the fuel tube
connector to release and disconnect the fuel
tube connector.
NOTICE:
Do not use any tools.
(4) After removing the fuel tube, check the sealing
surface of the pipe for dirt or mud.
If it dirty, wipe it off with a shop rag.
A088337E02
Plastic Bag
(5) Cover the disconnected fuel tube connector and
pipe with a plastic bag to prevent damage and
intrusion of foreign objects.
A088338E05
(e) Take the following precautions when installing the
fuel tube connector (Type A).
(1) Align the fuel tube connector with the pipe, then
push in the fuel tube connector until the retainer
makes a "click" sound.
HINT:
If they are connected too tightly, apply a light
coat of engine oil to the tip of the pipe, then
install the fuel tube connector.
Push
A088339E04
(2) After connecting the fuel tube connector, check
that the fuel tube connector and pipe are
securely connected by pulling them.
Pull
A088340E03
FU
FU–4
1NZ-FXE FUEL – FUEL SYSTEM
(f)
Pinch
Retainer
Take the following precautions when removing the
fuel tube connector (Type B).
(1) Check the fuel tube connector and pipe for dirt
or mud before removing the fuel tube connector.
If they are dirty, wipe them off with a shop rag.
(2) Pinch the retainer as illustrated, then pull out the
fuel tube connector from the pipe.
Pinch
Pull Out
A088341E05
(3) If the fuel connector and pipe are stuck, pinch
the pipe, then push and pull the fuel tube
connector to release and disconnect the fuel
tube connector.
NOTICE:
Do not use any tools.
(4) After removing the fuel tube, check the sealing
surface of the pipe for dirt or mud.
If it is dirty, wipe it off with a shop rag.
FU
A088343E04
(5) Cover the disconnected fuel tube connector and
pipe with a plastic bag to prevent damage and
intrusion of foreign objects.
Plastic Bag
A093867E02
(g) Take the following precautions when installing the
fuel tube connector (Type B).
(1) Align the fuel tube connector with the pipe, then
push in the fuel tube connector until the retainer
makes a "click" sound.
HINT:
If they are connected too tightly, apply a light
coat of engine oil to the tip of the pipe, then
install the fuel tube connector.
A088344E01
4.
A088345E04
(2) After connecting the fuel tube connector, check
that the fuel tube connector and pipe are
securely connected by pulling them.
CHECK FOR FUEL LEAKS
(a) Check that there are no fuel leaks after doing
maintenance on the fuel system (see page FU-7).
FU–5
1NZ-FXE FUEL – FUEL SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU
ECM
FU
FUEL TANK
ENGINE ROOM RELAY BLOCK,
JUNCTION BLOCK
- INTEGRATION RELAY
(UNIT B: IG2 RELAY)
(UNIT C: C/OPN RELAY)
- AM2 FUSE
- P/I H-FUSE
DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
- IGN FUSE
FUEL INJECTOR
A112282E01
FU–6
1NZ-FXE FUEL – FUEL SYSTEM
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
ECM
Integration Relay (Unit B)
IG2
No. 1 Fuel Injector
AM2
#10
No. 2 Fuel Injector
#20
FU
Power Source Control ECU
No. 3 Fuel Injector
#30
IG2D
No. 4 Fuel Injector
#40
from P/I H-Fuse
+B
Integration Relay
(Unit B)
C/OPN
from IGN Fuse
FC
Fuel Pump
E1
A112330E01
1NZ-FXE FUEL – FUEL SYSTEM
FU–7
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
Fuel Tube Connector
Cutter Knife
Protector
A112284E01
CHECK FUEL PRESSURE
(a) Prepare for the inspection.
(1) Prepare a new fuel tube.
HINT:
Part No. 23901-21081
(2) Using a cutter knife, cut off the protector of the
fuel tube as illustrated. Tear off the protector by
hand, then remove the fuel tube connector.
NOTICE:
If the protector is cut too deeply using the
cutter, the O-ring of the fuel tube connector
will be damaged.
(b) Discharge fuel system pressure (see page FU-12).
(c) Using a voltmeter, measure the battery voltage.
Standard voltage:
9.0 to 14 V
(d) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal.
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner
activation.
(e) Disconnect the fuel tube (see page FU-14).
(f)
SST (Pressure
Gauge)
SST (Hose)
Fuel Tube
SST (T-joint)
SST (Hose)
Fuel Tube
Connector
A112285E01
Install SST and the fuel tube connector to the
vehicle.
SST 09268-41047 (95336-08070), 09268-45014
(09268-41200, 09268-41220, 09268-41250)
(g) Wipe off any spilt gasoline.
(h) Connect the cable to the negative battery terminal.
FU
FU–8
1NZ-FXE FUEL – FUEL SYSTEM
(i)
(j)
Intelligent Tester
CAN VIM
DLC3
A087542E05
(k)
(l)
(m)
(n)
FU
(o)
(p)
(q)
(r)
Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
Measure the fuel pressure.
Standard:
304 to 343 kPa (3.1 to 3.5 kgf/cm2, 44 to 50 psi)
• If the fuel pressure is greater than the standard
value, replace the fuel tank.
• If the fuel pressure is less than the standard
value, check the connection of the fuel hose and
fuel tank.
Disconnect the intelligent tester from the DLC3.
Set the vehicle to inspection mode (see page IN34).
Start the engine.
Measure the fuel pressure at idle.
Standard:
304 to 343 kPa (3.1 to 3.5 kgf/cm2, 44 to 50 psi)
Stop the engine.
After stopping the engine, check that the fuel
pressure does not change for 5 minutes.
Standard:
147 kPa (1.5 kgf/cm2, 21 psi) or more
If the fuel pressure is not as specified, check the fuel
tank or fuel injectors (see page FU-15).
After measuring the fuel pressure, disconnect the
cable from the negative battery terminal. Remove
SST and the fuel tube connector while taking care to
prevent spilling gasoline.
Connect the fuel tube (see page FU-18).
2.
CHECK FUEL PUMP
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
NOTICE:
Do not start the engine.
(c) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(d) Select the item: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED OBD II /
ACTIVE TEST / FUEL PUMP / SPD.
(e) Check the fuel pump operation while operating it
with the intelligent tester.
If the fuel pump does not operate, replace the fuel
tank.
3.
CHECK FOR FUEL LEAKS
(a) Check that there are no leaks in the fuel system
while fuel pressure is applied.
Intelligent Tester
CAN VIM
DLC3
A087542E05
FU–9
1NZ-FXE FUEL – FUEL INJECTOR
FUEL INJECTOR
1NZ-FXE FUEL
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
WINDSHIELD WIPER ARM COVER
21 (214, 16)
21 (214, 16)
x2
FRONT WIPER ARM LH
FU
FRONT WIPER ARM RH
HOOD TO COWL TOP SEAL
COWL TOP VENTILATION
LOUVER RH
x5
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
COWL TOP VENTILATION
LOUVER LH
WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR AND LINK
WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR CONNECTOR
6.4 (65, 57 in.*lbf)
x7
8.4 (86, 74 in.*lbf)
x2
NO. 2 ENGINE ROOM RELAY BLOCK
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
FRONT OUTER COWL TOP PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
A112286E01
FU–10
1NZ-FXE FUEL – FUEL INJECTOR
AIR CLEANER
ASSEMBLY
NO. 1 AIR CLEANER INLET
7.0 (71, 62 in.*lbf)
x2
BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER
RESERVOIR SUB-ASSEMBLY
8.5 (87, 75 in.*lbf)
FU
x2
3.0 (31, 27 in.*lbf)
MAF METER CONNECTOR
8.5 (87, 75 in.*lbf)
x3
3.0 (31, 27 in.*lbf)
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
RESERVOIR BRACKET
x3
IGNITION COIL CONNECTOR
FUEL INJECTOR CONNECTOR
NO. 2 FUEL VAPOR FEED HOSE
BRAKE FLUID LEVEL SWITCH CONNECTOR
BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER
RESERVOIR COVER
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf)
: Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A112287E03
FU–11
1NZ-FXE FUEL – FUEL INJECTOR
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
NO. 1 IGNITION COIL
x4
10 (102, 7)
SEAL WASHER
x2
10 (102, 7)
x2
x7
CYLINDER HEAD COVER
SUB-ASSEMBLY
FU
O-RING
FUEL INJECTOR ASSEMBLY
NO. 1 FUEL PIPE CLAMP
19 (194, 14)
VENTILATION HOSE
NO. 2 VENTILATION HOSE
x2
FUEL TUBE SUB-ASSEMBLY
FUEL DELIVERY PIPE
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
x4
INJECTOR VIBRATION
INSULATOR
x2
NO. 1 DELIVERY PIPE
SPACER
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A112289E03
FU–12
1NZ-FXE FUEL – FUEL INJECTOR
REMOVAL
1.
DISCHARGE FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE
CAUTION:
• DISCHARGE FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE
procedures must be performed before
disconnecting any part of the fuel system.
• After performing the DISCHARGE FUEL SYSTEM
PRESSURE procedures, pressure will remain in
the fuel line. When disconnecting the fuel line,
place a cloth or equivalent over fittings to reduce
the risk of fuel spray.
(a) Remove the integration relay (unit C: C/OPN relay)
from the engine room junction block.
(b) Start the engine. After the engine has stopped, turn
the power switch OFF.
HINT:
DTC P0171 (system too lean) may be set.
(c) Check that the engine does not start.
(d) Remove the fuel tank cap, and let the air out of the
fuel tank.
(e) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal.
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner
activation.
(f) Install the integration relay (unit C: C/OPN relay) to
the engine room junction block.
2.
REMOVE WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR AND LINK
(a) Remove the windshield wiper motor and link (see
page WW-13).
3.
REMOVE FRONT OUTER COWL TOP PANEL SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and disconnect the No. 2
engine room relay block.
(b) Remove the 4 wire harness clamps.
FU
A087418E01
(c) Remove the 7 bolts and panel.
4.
A087419E01
REMOVE AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY (See page ES450)
1NZ-FXE FUEL – FUEL INJECTOR
FU–13
5.
REMOVE BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER RESERVOIR
SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the brake fluid level switch connector.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts.
(c) Disconnect the claw fitting, then remove the brake
master cylinder reservoir.
6.
REMOVE RESERVOIR BRACKET
(a) Remove the No. 2 fuel vapor feed hose from the
hose clamp.
(b) Remove the connector clamp.
(c) Remove the wire harness clamp.
(d) Remove the 3 bolts and reservoir bracket.
A087420E02
A087421E01
7.
REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 wire harness clamps.
(b) Disconnect the 4 fuel injector connectors.
(c) Disconnect the 4 ignition coil connectors.
(d) Remove the 3 bolts, then remove the engine wire
and brake master cylinder reservoir cover.
A132572
(e) Remove the 4 bolts and 4 ignition coils.
A132573
(f)
Disconnect the ventilation hose from the ventilation
valve.
(g) Disconnect the No. 2 ventilation hose from the
cylinder head cover.
A087608E01
FU
FU–14
1NZ-FXE FUEL – FUEL INJECTOR
(h) Remove the 9 bolts, 2 seal washers, 2 nuts and
cylinder head cover.
FU
A132574
8.
No. 1 Pipe Clamp
REMOVE FUEL DELIVERY PIPE
(a) Disconnect the fuel tube from the fuel delivery pipe.
(1) Remove the No. 1 fuel pipe clamp.
Pull Out
Pinch
A112290E01
Nylon Tube
Fuel Tube Connector O-Ring
Retainer
Pipe
A075650E15
(2) Pinch the retainer of the fuel tube connector,
and then pull out the fuel tube connector to
disconnect the fuel tube from the fuel delivery
pipe.
NOTICE:
• Remove dirt or foreign objects on the
fuel tube connector before this
procedure.
• Do not allow any scratches or foreign
objects on the parts when disconnecting
them, as the fuel tube connector has the
O-ring that seals the pipe.
• Perform this work by hand. Do not use
any tools.
• Do not forcibly bend, twist or turn the
nylon tube.
1NZ-FXE FUEL – FUEL INJECTOR
FU–15
• Protect the connecting part by covering it
with a plastic bag after disconnecting the
fuel tube.
• If the fuel tube connector and pipe are
stuck, push and pull them to release
them.
(b) Remove the 3 bolts and fuel delivery pipe together
with the 4 fuel injectors.
NOTICE:
Do not drop the fuel injectors when removing
the fuel delivery pipe.
A087611E01
(c) Remove the 2 No. 1 delivery pipe spacers from the
cylinder head.
(d) Remove the 4 insulators from the cylinder head.
A087612E01
9.
Pull Out
REMOVE FUEL INJECTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Pull out the 4 fuel injectors from the fuel delivery
pipe.
A088222E01
INSPECTION
1.
A087468E02
INSPECT FUEL INJECTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Measure the resistance between the terminals.
Standard resistance:
13.45 to 14.15 Ω at 21°C (68°F)
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the fuel
injector assembly.
FU
FU–16
1NZ-FXE FUEL – FUEL INJECTOR
Fuel Tube Connector
Cutter Knife
Protector
A112284E01
FU
(b) Inspect the injection volume.
CAUTION:
Perform the test in a well-ventilated area away
from flames.
NOTICE:
Carefully handle the fuel tube connector.
(1) Prepare a new fuel tube.
HINT:
Part No. 23901-21081
(2) Using a cutter knife, cut off the protector of the
fuel tube as illustrated. Tear off the protector by
hand, then remove the fuel tube connector.
NOTICE:
If the protector is cut too deeply using the
cutter, the O-ring of the fuel tube connector
will be damaged.
(3) Install SST to the fuel tube connector, and
connect the fuel tube connector to the fuel pipe
(the vehicle side).
SST 09268-41047 (95336-08070)
SST
(Hose)
Fuel Pipe
Fuel Tube Connector
A088228E09
SST
(Hose)
SST
(Clamp)
SST
(Union)
(4) Install a new O-ring to the fuel injector.
(5) Install SST and the vinyl tube to the fuel
injector.
SST 09268-41047 (09268-41110, 0926841300)
New
O-Ring
Vinyl Tube
A088230E02
(6) Set the fuel injector to a graduated cylinder.
(7) Actuate the fuel pump (see page FU-7).
(8) Install SST to the fuel injector.
SST 09842-30080
SST
Battery
Graduated
Cylinder
A088346E03
FU–17
1NZ-FXE FUEL – FUEL INJECTOR
(9) Connect SST to the battery, then measure the
injection volume for 15 seconds. Perform the
inspection 2 or 3 times, then calculate the
average.
Standard injection volume
Injection Volume
Difference between each fuel
injector
36 to 46 cm3 (2.1 to 2.8 cu in.)
10 cm3 (0.6 cu in.) or less
NOTICE:
Always turn the voltage on and off on the
battery side, not the fuel injector side.
If the injection volume is not as specified,
replace the fuel injector assembly.
(c) Inspect the leakage.
(1) In the condition that the injection volume was
inspected, remove SST from the battery.
Inspect the fuel leakage from the fuel injector.
Standard fuel drop:
1 drop or less per 12 minutes
If the fuel leakage is not as specified, replace
the fuel injector assembly.
A088303E01
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL FUEL INJECTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Apply a light coat of spindle oil or gasoline to a new
O-ring, then install it to each fuel injector.
New O-Ring
A087548E02
Push
Turn
A088223E02
(b) Apply a light coat of spindle oil or gasoline to the
surface of the fuel delivery pipe which contacts the
O-ring of the fuel injector.
(c) Apply a light coat of spindle oil or gasoline to the Oring again, and install the fuel injector by turning it
right and left while pushing it onto the fuel delivery
pipe.
NOTICE:
Be careful that the O-ring is not cracked or
jammed when installing it.
(d) Check that the fuel injector rotates smoothly.
If the fuel injector does not rotate, replace the Oring.
FU
FU–18
1NZ-FXE FUEL – FUEL INJECTOR
2.
INSTALL FUEL DELIVERY PIPE
(a) Install 4 new insulators to the cylinder head.
(b) Install the 2 No. 1 delivery pipe spacers to the
cylinder head.
NOTICE:
Be careful of the installation direction of the
delivery pipe spacer.
A088224E01
(c) Install the fuel delivery pipe together with the 4 fuel
injectors, and then temporarily tighten the 3 bolts.
NOTICE:
Do not drop the fuel injectors when installing
the fuel delivery pipe.
(d) Check that the fuel injectors rotate smoothly.
If the fuel injectors do not rotate, replace the O-ring.
(e) Retighten the 3 bolts to the specified torque.
Torque: 19 N*m (194 kgf*cm, 14 ft.*lbf) for bolt A
9.0 N*m (92 kgf*cm, 80 in.*lbf) for bolt B
B
Rotate
FU
A
A
A088225E02
(f)
Push
Fuel Pipe
Clamp
A087544E04
2
1
3
A087421E02
Connect the fuel tube to the fuel delivery pipe.
(1) Align the fuel tube connector with the pipe, then
push in the fuel tube connector until the retainer
makes a "click" sound to connect the fuel tube
to the fuel delivery pipe.
NOTICE:
• Check that there are no scratches or
foreign objects around the connected
part of the fuel tube connector and pipe
before this work.
• After connecting the fuel tube, check that
the fuel tube connector and pipe are
securely connected by pulling them.
(2) Install the No. 1 fuel pipe clamp.
3.
INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(See page EM-39)
4.
INSTALL RESERVOIR BRACKET
(a) Temporarily install the reservoir bracket with the bolt
labeled 1 in the illustration.
(b) Tighten the 3 bolts to the specified torque in the
sequence shown in the illustration.
Torque: 8.5 N*m (87 kgf*cm, 75 in.*lbf)
(c) Install the connector clamp.
(d) Install the wire harness clamp.
(e) Install the No. 2 fuel vapor feed hose to the hose
clamp.
1NZ-FXE FUEL – FUEL INJECTOR
FU–19
5.
INSTALL BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER RESERVOIR
(a) Install the reservoir with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 8.5 N*m (87 kgf*cm, 75 in.*lbf)
(b) Connect the switch connector.
6.
INSTALL AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY (See page ES453)
7.
INSTALL FRONT OUTER COWL TOP PANEL SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Install the panel with the 7 bolts.
Torque: 6.4 N*m (65 kgf*cm, 57 in.*lbf)
A087420E03
FU
A087419E01
(b) Connect the 4 wire harness clamps.
(c) Install the No. 2 engine room relay block with the 2
bolts.
Torque: 8.4 N*m (86 kgf*cm, 74 in.*lbf)
A087418E01
8.
INSTALL WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR AND LINK
(a) Install the windshield wiper motor and link (see page
WW-15).
9.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
10. CHECK FOR FUEL LEAKS (See page FU-8)
11. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
FU–20
1NZ-FXE FUEL – FUEL TANK
FUEL TANK
1NZ-FXE FUEL
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL LOWER CENTER
CLIP
FU
x2
CLIP
POWER OUTLET CONNECTOR
GASKET
FRONT FLOOR CARPET ASSEMBLY
COMPRESSION SPRING
FRONT EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY
43 (440, 32)
x2
GASKET
x2
43 (440, 32)
COMPRESSION SPRING
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
FRONT FLOOR PANEL BRACE
x4
30 (302, 22)
Non-reusable part
A112292E03
FU–21
1NZ-FXE FUEL – FUEL TANK
REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY
REAR FLOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER
FUEL TANK INLET PIPE SUB-ASSEMBLY
WIRE TO WIRE CONNECTOR
FUEL TUBE CONNECTOR
FUEL PUMP CONNECTOR
FUEL FILLER PIPE CLAMP
FUEL TANK ASSEMBLY
NO. 1 FUEL TANK BAND
SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
NO. 1 FUEL TANK BAND
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
x2
39 (400, 29)
x2
39 (400, 29)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A112293E03
FU
FU–22
1NZ-FXE FUEL – FUEL TANK
FUEL TANK TO CANISTER TUBE
FUEL TANK VENT HOSE
CLAMP
x2
FUEL SUCTION TUBE SUB-ASSEMBLY
NO. 1 FUEL TUBE CLAMP
NO. 2 FUEL TANK MAIN TUBE SUB-ASSEMBLY
FU
CLAMP
x2
x2
6.0 (61, 53 in.*lbf)
FUEL TANK WIRE
TRAP CANISTER WITH
PUMP MODULE
FUEL TANK PRESSURE SENSOR
FUEL TANK
RETAINER LH
FUEL TANK BREATHER
TUBE GASKET
TUBE JOINT CLIP
CANISTER HOSE
6.0 (61, 53 in.*lbf)
FUEL TANK BREATHER
TUBE GASKET
x2
6.0 (61, 53 in.*lbf)
NO. 1
CANISTER
TUBE
x3
REAR FUEL TANK BRACKET
NO. 1 FUEL TANK CUSHION
CLAMP
CANISTER
x9
NO. 1 CANISTER OUTLET
HOSE
NUT
FUEL TANK ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A112294E03
1NZ-FXE FUEL – FUEL TANK
FU–23
REMOVAL
1.
DISCHARGE FUEL SYSTEM PRESSURE (See page
FU-12)
2.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL
LOWER CENTER (See page IP-18)
3.
REMOVE FRONT FLOOR PANEL BRACE (See page
EX-2)
4.
REMOVE FRONT EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY (See
page EX-2)
5.
REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY (See
page SE-15)
6.
REMOVE REAR FLOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER
(a) Remove the butyl tape and rear floor service hole
cover.
(b) Disconnect the fuel pump connector.
(c) Disconnect the wire to wire connector.
Butyl Tape
A087483E02
7.
Pull Out
Pinch
Pinch
Nylon Tube
Retainer
O-Ring
Tank to Canister Tube Connector
Pipe
A112310E01
REMOVE FUEL TANK ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the fuel tank to canister tube.
(1) Pinch the retainer of the fuel tube connector,
then pull out the fuel tube connector to
disconnect the fuel tank to canister tube from
the pipe.
NOTICE:
• Remove dirt or foreign objects on the
fuel tube connector before this
procedure.
• Do not allow any scratches or foreign
objects on the parts when disconnecting
them as the fuel tube connector has the
O-ring that seals the pipe.
• Perform this work by hand. Do not use
any tools.
• Do not forcibly bend, twist or turn the
nylon tube.
• Protect the connecting part by covering it
with a plastic bag after disconnecting the
fuel tank to canister tube.
• If the fuel tube connector and pipe are
stuck, push and pull them to release
them.
FU
FU–24
1NZ-FXE FUEL – FUEL TANK
: Pinch
: Pull Out
Nylon Tube
O-Ring
Fuel Tube
Connector
FU
Pipe
Retainer
A112311E02
Push
Pinch
O-Ring
Pipe
Fuel Tank Vent
Hose Connector
Nylon Tube
A112312E02
(b) Disconnect the No. 2 fuel tank main tube.
(1) Remove the checker of the fuel tube connector
from the pipe.
(2) Pinch the retainer of the fuel tube connector,
and then pull out the fuel tube connector to
disconnect the No. 2 fuel tank main tube from
the pipe.
NOTICE:
• Remove dirt or foreign objects on the
fuel tube connector before this
procedure.
• Do not allow any scratches or foreign
objects on the parts when disconnecting
them as the fuel tube connector has the
O-ring that seals the pipe.
• Perform this work by hand. Do not use
any tools.
• Do not forcibly bend, twist or turn the
nylon tube.
• Protect the connecting part by covering it
with a plastic bag after disconnecting the
No. 2 fuel tank main tube.
• If the fuel tube connector and pipe are
stuck, push and pull them to release
them.
(c) Disconnect the fuel tank vent hose.
(1) Pinch the retainer and pull out the fuel tank
vent hose connector with the fuel tank vent
hose connector pushed to the pipe side to
disconnect the fuel tank vent hose from the
canister filter.
NOTICE:
• Remove dirt or foreign objects on the
fuel tank vent hose connector before this
procedure.
• Do not allow any scratches or foreign
objects on the parts when disconnecting
them as the fuel tank vent hose
connector has the O-ring that seals the
pipe.
• Perform this work by hand. Do not use
any tools.
• Do not forcibly bend, twist or turn the
nylon tube.
• Protect the connecting part by covering it
with a plastic bag after disconnecting the
fuel tank vent hose.
• If the fuel tank vent hose connector and
pipe are stuck, push and pull them to
release them.
1NZ-FXE FUEL – FUEL TANK
Push
Pinch
Retainer
Quick Connector
Pipe
Nylon Tube
O-Ring
A112313E01
Push
Pinch
Retainer
Quick Connector
Nylon Tube
Pipe
O-Ring
A112314E01
FU–25
(d) Disconnect the fuel suction tube.
(1) Pinch the retainer and pull out the suction tube
connector with the suction tube connector
pushed to the pipe side to disconnect the fuel
suction tube from the fuel tank to filler pipe.
NOTICE:
• Remove dirt or foreign objects on the
quick connector before this procedure.
• Do not allow any scratches or foreign
objects on the parts when disconnecting
them as the fuel suction tube connector
has the O-ring that seals the pipe.
• Perform this work by hand. Do not use
any tools.
• Do not forcibly bend, twist or turn the
nylon tube.
• Protect the connecting part by covering it
with a plastic bag after disconnecting the
fuel suction tube.
• If the fuel suction tube connector and
pipe are stuck, push and pull them to
release them.
(e) Disconnect the No. 1 canister tube.
(1) Pinch the retainer and pull out the No. 1
canister tube connector with the No. 1 canister
tube connector pushed to the pipe side to
disconnect the No. 1 canister tube from the fuel
tank to filler pipe.
NOTICE:
• Remove dirt or foreign objects on the
quick connector before this procedure.
• Do not allow any scratches or foreign
objects on the parts when disconnecting
them as the No. 1 canister tube
connector has the O-ring that seals the
pipe.
• Perform this work by hand. Do not use
any tools.
• Do not forcibly bend, twist or turn the
nylon tube.
• Protect the connecting part by covering it
with a plastic bag after disconnecting the
tank to canister tube.
• If the No. 1 canister tube connector and
pipe are stuck, push and pull them to
release them.
FU
FU–26
1NZ-FXE FUEL – FUEL TANK
(f) Set a transmission jack to the fuel tank.
(g) Remove the fuel filler pipe clamp and fuel tube
connector from the fuel tank inlet pipe.
(h) Remove the 4 bolts and No. 1 fuel tank band RH
and LH.
(i) Operate the transmission jack, and then disconnect
the fuel tank inlet pipe.
(j) Operate the transmission jack, and then remove the
fuel tank.
Fuel Tube Connector
FU
Fuel Filler Pipe Clamp
A087489E02
8.
A114369
REMOVE NO. 2 FUEL TANK MAIN TUBE SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 3 nuts and rear fuel tank bracket.
(b) Disconnect the wire to wire connector from the rear
fuel tank bracket.
1NZ-FXE FUEL – FUEL TANK
FU–27
(c) Disconnect the No. 2 fuel tank main tube from the
clamp.
(d) Remove the checker of the main tube connector
from the pipe.
(e) Pinch the retainer of the main tube connector, then
pull out the fuel tube connector to disconnect the
No. 2 fuel tank main tube from the pipe.
NOTICE:
• Remove dirt or foreign objects on the fuel
tube connector before this procedure.
• Do not allow any scratches or foreign objects
on the parts when disconnecting them as the
fuel tube connector has the O-ring that seals
the pipe.
• Perform this work by hand. Do not use any
tools.
• Do not forcibly bend, twist or turn the nylon
tube.
• Protect the connecting part by covering it
with a plastic bag after disconnecting the No.
2 fuel tank main tube.
• If the fuel tube connector and pipe are stuck,
push and pull them to release them.
Checker
Pull Out
Pinch
Fuel Tube Connector
Nylon Tube
O-Ring
Pipe
Retainer
A112315E02
9.
Pinch
Push
Pinch
Retainer
Pipe
Quick Connector
Nylon Tube
O-Ring
A112316E01
REMOVE FUEL SUCTION TUBE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the fuel suction tube from the 2 No. 1
fuel tube clamps.
(b) Pinch the retainer and pull out the suction tube
connector with the quick connector pushed to the
pipe side to disconnect the fuel suction tube from
the pipe.
NOTICE:
• Remove dirt or foreign objects on the quick
connector before this procedure.
• Do not allow any scratches or foreign objects
on the parts when disconnecting them as the
suction tube connector has the O-ring that
seals the pipe.
• Perform this work by hand. Do not use any
tools.
• Do not forcibly bend, twist or turn the nylon
tube.
• Protect the connecting part by covering it
with a plastic bag after disconnecting the fuel
suction tube.
• If the quick connector and pipe are stuck,
push and pull them to release them.
FU
FU–28
1NZ-FXE FUEL – FUEL TANK
10. REMOVE FUEL TANK TO CANISTER TUBE
(a) Disconnect the fuel tank to canister tube from the
clamp.
(b) Disconnect the fuel tank to canister tube from the 2
No. 1 fuel tube clamps.
(c) Remove the fuel tank to canister tube from the fuel
tank.
A114370
11. REMOVE TRAP CANISTER WITH PUMP MODULE
(a) Disconnect the VSV connector.
(b) Remove the clamp from the fuel tank vent hose and
canister hose.
(c) Remove the fuel tank vent hose from the 2 fuel tube
clamps.
(d) Remove the 2 bolts and trap canister with pump
module and disconnect the ground terminal of the
fuel tank wire.
FU
A114371
(e) Remove the gasket from the fuel tank.
A087502E01
(f)
A128672
Remove the 2 clamps from the trap canister with
pump module.
1NZ-FXE FUEL – FUEL TANK
Pinch
Push
Fuel Tank Vent Hose Connector
Pipe
Retainer
O-Ring
Nylon Tube
A112317E01
C
D
B
D
D
A
FU–29
12. REMOVE FUEL TANK VENT HOSE
(a) Pinch the retainer and pull out the fuel tank vent
hose connector with the fuel tank vent hose
connector pushed to the fuel tank vent hose side to
disconnect the fuel tank vent hose from the trap with
outlet valve canister.
NOTICE:
• Remove dirt of foreign objects on the fuel
tank vent hose connector before this
procedure.
• Do not allow any scratches or foreign objects
on the parts when disconnecting them as the
fuel tank vent hose connector has the O-ring
that seals the pipe.
• Perform this work by hand. Do not use any
tools.
• Do not forcibly bend, twist or turn the nylon
tube.
• Protect the connecting part by covering it
with a plastic bag after disconnecting the fuel
tank vent hose.
• If the fuel tank vent hose connector and pipe
are stuck, push and pull them to release
them.
13. REMOVE FUEL TANK WIRE
(a) Remove the clamp as shown in the illustration A.
(b) Disconnect the VSV connector as shown in the
illustration B.
(c) Disconnect the vapor pressure sensor connector as
shown in the illustration C.
(d) Remove the 3 wire harness clamps as shown in the
illustration D.
A087496E05
14. REMOVE CANISTER
(a) Disconnect the canister hose from the fuel tank
retainer.
(b) Disconnect the No. 1 canister outlet hose from the
fuel tank.
(c) Remove the bolt, 2 nuts and canister.
A087497E01
FU
FU–30
1NZ-FXE FUEL – FUEL TANK
(d) Remove the nut from the fuel tank.
A087498E01
15. REMOVE FUEL TANK PRESSURE SENSOR
(a) Remove the tube joint clip, then pull out the fuel tank
pressure sensor from the fuel tank retainer LH.
NOTICE:
• Remove dirt or foreign objects on fuel tank
pressure sensor before this procedure.
• Do not allow any scratches or foreign objects
on the parts when disconnecting them as the
fuel tank pressure sensor has the O-ring that
seals the plug.
• Perform this work by hand. Do not use any
tools.
Pull Out
FU
Tube Joint Clip
Fuel Tank Pressure Sensor
Tube Joint Clip
O-Ring
A112318E05
Fuel Tank
Retainer
Clip
Remover
Gasket
A087500E02
16. REMOVE FUEL TANK RETAINER LH
(a) Insert a clip remover between the fuel tank retainer
and gasket, then remove the fuel tank retainer by
lifting it little by little.
NOTICE:
• The fuel tank retainer is made of resin and
easily damaged if removed or installed
forcibly. Handle the part correctly to ensure
proper sealing.
• After removing the fuel tank retainer, check
that the contact surface of the fuel tank
retainer on the fuel tank is not damaged.
1NZ-FXE FUEL – FUEL TANK
FU–31
(b) Remove the gasket from the fuel tank.
A087513E01
17. REMOVE NO. 1 FUEL TUBE CLAMP
(a) Remove the 2 clamps from the fuel tank.
FU
A087501E01
18. REMOVE NO. 1 FUEL TANK CUSHION
(a) Remove the 9 cushions from the fuel tank.
A132605
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT FUEL TANK ASSEMBLY WITH FUEL PUMP
(a) Measure the resistance between terminals 3 and 7.
Standard resistance:
0.2 to 3.0 Ω at 20°C (68°F)
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the fuel
tank assembly.
A087570E02
A087571E02
(b) Check that the motor operates when battery voltage
is applied across the terminals.
NOTICE:
• Perform the check quickly (shorter than 10
seconds).
• Keep the battery as far away the fuel tank as
possible.
• Always turn the voltage on and off on the
battery side, not the fuel tank side.
If the motor does not operate, replace the fuel tank
assembly.
FU–32
1NZ-FXE FUEL – FUEL TANK
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL NO. 1 FUEL TANK CUSHION
(a) Install 9 new cushions to the fuel tank.
2.
INSTALL NO. 1 FUEL TUBE CLAMP
(a) Install the 2 clamps to the fuel tank.
3.
INSTALL FUEL TANK RETAINER LH
(a) Install a new gasket to the fuel tank.
(b) While being careful that the gasket does not drop in
the fuel tank, insert the fuel tank retainer LH to the
fuel tank so the protrusion of the fuel tank retainer
LH is in the middle of the 2 convex pats of the fuel
tank.
4.
INSTALL FUEL TANK PRESSURE SENSOR
(a) Push the fuel tank pressure sensor to the plug of the
fuel tank retainer LH, and then install the tube joint
clip.
NOTICE:
• Check that there are no scratches or foreign
objects around the connected part of the fuel
tank pressure sensor and fuel tank retainer
LH before this procedure.
• Check that the fuel tank pressure sensor is
securely inserted to the end.
• Check that the tube joint clip is on the collar
of the fuel tank pressure sensor.
• After installing the tube joint clip, check that
the fuel tank pressure sensor cannot be
pulled out.
A132605
FU
A087501E01
Protrusion
Convex
Gasket
A087505E02
Push
Collar
Tube Joint Clip
A087506E02
1NZ-FXE FUEL – FUEL TANK
5.
FU–33
INSTALL CANISTER
(a) Install the nut to the fuel tank.
A087498E01
(b) Install the canister with the bolt and 2 nuts.
Torque: 6.0 N*m (61 kgf*cm, 53 in.*lbf)
(c) Connect the No. 1 canister outlet hose to the fuel
tank.
(d) Connect the canister hose to the fuel tank retainer.
FU
A087497E01
C
D
6.
INSTALL FUEL TANK WIRE
(a) Install the 3 wire harness clamps as shown in the
illustration D.
(b) Connect the vapor pressure sensor connector as
shown in the illustration C.
(c) Connect the VSV connector as shown in the
illustration B.
(d) Install the clamp as shown in the illustration A.
7.
INSTALL FUEL TANK VENT HOSE
(a) Align the fuel tank vent hose connector with the
pipe, then push in the fuel tank vent hose connector
until the retainer makes a "click" sound to install the
fuel tank vent hose to the trap canister with pump
module.
NOTICE:
• Check that there are no scratches or foreign
objects around the connected part of the fuel
tank vent hose connector and pipe before this
procedure.
• After connecting the fuel tank vent hose,
check that the fuel tank vent hose is securely
connected by pulling the fuel tank vent hose
connector.
B
D
D
A
A087496E05
Push
A114372E02
FU–34
1NZ-FXE FUEL – FUEL TANK
8.
INSTALL TRAP CANISTER WITH PUMP MODULE
(a) Install a new gasket to the fuel tank.
(b) Insert the trap canister with pump module to the fuel
tank.
NOTICE:
Be careful that the gasket does not drop in the
fuel tank.
A087504E01
(c) Install the 2 clamps to the trap canister with pump
module.
FU
A128672
(d) Install the trap canister with pump module and
connect the ground terminal of the fuel tank wire
with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 6.0 N*m (61 kgf*cm, 53 in.*lbf)
(e) Install the fuel tank vent hose to the 2 fuel tube
clamps.
(f) Install the clamp to the fuel tank vent hose and
canister hose.
(g) Connect the VSV connector.
A114371
9.
INSTALL FUEL TANK TO CANISTER TUBE
(a) Install the fuel tank to canister tube to the canister's
hose.
(b) Connect the fuel tank to canister tube to the 2 No. 1
fuel tube clamps.
A114370
Push
A114373E01
10. INSTALL FUEL SUCTION TUBE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Align the suction tube connector with the pipe, and
then push in the suction tube connector until the
retainer makes a "click" sound to install the fuel
suction tube to the pipe.
NOTICE:
• Check that there are no scratches or foreign
objects around the connected part of the
quick connector and pipe before this
procedure.
1NZ-FXE FUEL – FUEL TANK
FU–35
• After connecting the fuel suction tube, check
that the fuel suction tube is securely
connected by pulling the suction tube
connector.
(b) Connect the fuel suction tube to the 2 No. 1 fuel
tube clamps.
Checker
Push
A114374E01
11. INSTALL NO. 2 FUEL TANK MAIN TUBE SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Align the main tube connector with the pipe, and
then push in the main tube connector until the
retainer makes a "click" sound to install the No. 2
fuel tank main tube to the pipe.
NOTICE:
• Check that there are no scratches or foreign
objects around the connected part of the fuel
tube connector.
• After connecting the No. 2 fuel tank main
tube, check that the No. 2 fuel tank main tube
is securely connected by pulling the main
tube connector.
(b) Install the checker to the pipe.
(c) Connect the No. 2 fuel tank main tube to the clamp.
(d) Connect the connector clamp to the rear fuel tank
bracket.
(e) Install the rear fuel tank bracket with the 3 nuts.
Torque: 6.0 N*m (61 kgf*cm, 53 in.*lbf)
A114369
12. INSTALL FUEL TANK ASSEMBLY
(a) Set the fuel tank to a transmission jack.
(b) Operate the transmission jack, and then install the
fuel tank to the vehicle.
(c) Operate the transmission jack, and then connect the
fuel tank inlet pipe.
FU
FU–36
1NZ-FXE FUEL – FUEL TANK
(d) Install the No. 1 fuel tank band RH and LH with the 4
bolts.
Torque: 39 N*m (400 kgf*cm, 29 ft.*lbf)
(e) Install the fuel tube connector and fuel filler pipe
clamp to the fuel tank inlet pipe.
Fuel Tube Connector
FU
Fuel Filler Pipe Clamp
A087489E02
(f)
Push
A087510E01
Push
A087511E01
Connect the No. 1 canister tube.
(1) Align the No. 1 canister tube connector with the
pipe, and then push in the No. 1 canister tube
connector until the retainer makes a "click"
sound to connect the No. 1 canister tube to the
fuel tank to filler pipe.
NOTICE:
• Check that there are no scratches or
foreign objects around the connected
part of the No. 1 canister tube connector
and pipe before this procedure.
• After connecting the No. 1 canister tube,
check that the No. 1 canister tube is
securely connected by pulling the No. 1
canister tube connector.
(g) Connect the fuel suction tube.
(1) Align the suction tube connector with the pipe,
and then push in the suction tube connector
until the retainer makes a "click" sound to
connect the fuel suction tube to the fuel tank to
filler pipe.
NOTICE:
• Check that there are no scratches or
foreign objects around the connected
part of the suction tube connector and
pipe before this procedure.
• After connecting the fuel suction tube,
check that the fuel suction tube is
securely connected by pulling the
suction tube connector.
1NZ-FXE FUEL – FUEL TANK
Push
A087512E01
(h) Connect the fuel tank vent hose.
(1) Align the fuel tank vent hose connector with the
pipe, and then push in the fuel tank vent hose
connector until the retainer makes a "click"
sound to connect the fuel tank vent hose to the
canister filter.
NOTICE:
• Check that there are no scratches or
foreign objects around the connected
part of the fuel tank vent hose connector
and pipe before this procedure.
• After connecting the fuel tank vent hose,
check that the fuel tank vent hose is
securely connected by pulling the vent
hose connector.
(i)
Checker
Push
A091721E02
(j)
Push
A087603E02
FU–37
Connect the No. 2 fuel tank main tube.
(1) Align the fuel tube connector with the pipe, and
then push in the fuel tube connector until the
retainer makes a "click" sound to connect the
No. 2 fuel tank main tube to the pipe.
NOTICE:
• Check that there are no scratches or
foreign objects around the connected
part of the fuel tube connector and pipe
before this procedure.
• After connecting the No. 2 fuel tank main
tube, check that the No. 2 fuel tank main
tube is securely connected by pulling the
quick connector.
Install the checker to the pipe.
(k) Connect the fuel tank to canister tube.
(1) Align the fuel tank to canister tube connector
with the pipe, and then push in the fuel tank to
canister tube connector until the retainer makes
a "click" sound to connect the fuel tank to
canister tube to the pipe.
NOTICE:
• Check that there are no scratches or
foreign objects around the connected
part of the fuel tank to canister tube
connector and pipe before this
procedure.
• After connecting the fuel tank to canister
tube, check that the fuel tank to canister
tube is securely connected by pulling the
quick connector.
13. INSTALL FRONT EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY (See
page EX-3)
14. CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
15. CHECK FOR FUEL LEAKS (See page FU-8)
16. CHECK FOR EXHAUST GAS LEAKS
FU
FU–38
1NZ-FXE FUEL – FUEL TANK
17. INSTALL FRONT FLOOR PANEL BRACE (See page
EX-4)
18. INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL
LOWER CENTER (See page IP-21)
New Butyl Tape
Convex
A087515E02
FU
19. INSTALL REAR FLOOR SERVICE HOLE COVER
(a) Attach new butyl tape to the rear floor service hole
cover.
(b) Connect the wire to wire connector.
(c) Connect the fuel pump connector.
(d) Install the rear floor service hole cover while
adjusting it to the 3 convex parts of the floor panel.
NOTICE:
Be careful that the rear floor service hole cover
does not overlap the convex parts of the floor
panel when installing.
20. INSTALL REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY (See
page SE-23)
21. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
GARAGE DOOR OPENER – GARAGE DOOR OPENER SYSTEM
GD–1
GARAGE DOOR OPENER SYSTEM
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
Garage Door, Gate Or Other
Tracsmitter Code Based System
Signal
Garage Door Opener
Garage Door Opener Switch
GD
Multiplex Communication System
ECU-IG
Power Source
Control ECU
IG1
DOME
DC/DC
Garage Door
Opener
MAIN
B139881E02
GD–2
GARAGE DOOR OPENER – GARAGE DOOR OPENER SYSTEM
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
A maximum of 3 kinds of transmitter code based systems (for
example garage doors, gates and entry gates) can be
registered with the vehicle's garage door opener. After
registration, the vehicle's garage door opener can mimic the
signal of the transmitter systems and the original transmitters
of each transmitter system are not needed.
GD
GARAGE DOOR OPENER – GARAGE DOOR OPENER SYSTEM
GD–3
REGISTRATION
1.
REGISTER TRANSMITTER CODE
HINT:
• The vehicle's garage door opener records transmitter
codes for systems such as garage doors, gates, entry
gates, door locks, home lighting systems, security
systems or other transmitter code based systems.
• The garage door opener is built into the No. 1 dome
light. If replacing the No. 1dome light, transmitter
codes for any systems previously registered in the
garage door opener must be reregistered.
(a) Register a system transmitter code in the garage
door opener system.
NOTICE:
• Do not perform transmitter code registration
for a system if people or objects are near the
system. When registering transmitter codes
for a system, injury or damage can occur
because the system may open, close, unlock
or otherwise operate.
• Before transmitter code registration, turn the
power switch OFF and remove the key from
the key slot.
• The garage door opener cannot be used with
systems that: 1) were manufactured before
April 1, 1982; or 2) do not meet Federal Safety
Standards (for example, garage doors without
a jam protection function).
HINT:
• 3 transmitter codes can be registered with the
garage door opener, one transmitter code for
each of the 3 garage door opener switches.
• Disconnecting the battery will not erase the
transmitter codes registered with the garage door
opener.
• An attempt to overwrite a previously registered
transmitter code with a new system's transmitter
code may fail. In these situations, the previously
registered transmitter code will not be erased.
(1) Select a garage door opener switch for
transmitter code registration.
(2) Press and hold the selected switch for 20
seconds. The garage door opener will enter
registration mode.
HINT:
Before entering registration mode, the LED is
ON. After entering registration mode, the LED
flashes at a cycle of 1 Hz. For a "rolling code"
type system, after entering registration mode,
the LED flashes at a cycle of 8.8 Hz for 1.6
seconds, and then the LED flashes at a cycle of
1 Hz.
GD
GD–4
GARAGE DOOR OPENER – GARAGE DOOR OPENER SYSTEM
(3) After the garage door opener has entered
registration mode, bring the original transmitter
of the system to be registered within 1 to 3
inches of the garage door opener and press
and hold one of the garage door opener
switches. Then press the original transmitter
switch.
(4) If the transmitter code registration was
successful, the LED of the garage door opener
flashes at a cycle of 5.6 Hz. If no malfunction
occurs, release both the garage door opener
switch and the original transmitter switch.
HINT:
• If transmitter code registration fails: 1) the
original transmitter's battery may be low or
need to be replaced, or 2) the system you
are trying to register may not be compatible
with the garage door opener.
• Some transmitter's signals stop after 1 to 2
seconds. For these types of transmitters: 1)
press and hold one of the garage door
opener switches, and 2) press and release
(cycle) the transmitter switch every 2
seconds. Check if the transmitter code was
successfully registered.
• After entering the garage door opener
registration mode, transmitter code
registration must be completed within 90
seconds. If 90 seconds elapse, the garage
door opener will enter low power mode (see
"Low power mode" description below).
GD
Timing chart of registration mode:
PRESSED
Garage Door
Opener Switch
RELEASED
ENTER
Registration
Mode
LED
Operation
20 sec.
EXIT
ON
OFF
LED flashes
cycle of 1 Hz
ON
Original
Transmitter
at a
LED flashes
cycle of 5.6 Hz
at a
OFF
I003487E13
GARAGE DOOR OPENER – GARAGE DOOR OPENER SYSTEM
GD–5
(b) Erase the transmitter codes in the garage door
opener clear mode.
HINT:
All 3 registered transmitter codes will be erased. No
option exists for only erasing one transmitter code.
(1) Press and hold the left and right switches of the
garage door opener for 20 seconds. The LED
will begin to flash at a cycle of 5.6 Hz.
Releasing the switches will end clear mode.
HINT:
• If the switches are released within 10
seconds after the transmitter codes have
been erased, the garage door opener will
enter registration mode.
• If the switches are held for 10 seconds or
more after the transmitter codes have been
erased, default codes will be set to the 3
switches of the garage door opener. Using
these default codes, operation of the garage
door opener can be checked using a tester.
LED
Press One of
These Switches
B075996E01
Timing chart of clear mode:
Garage Door
Switches
ends)
PRESSED
Opener
(at both
RELEASED
Enter clear mode to erase
all 3 codes
20 sec.
Clear Mode / Default Mode
GD
Load Default Code
ON
10 sec.
OFF
ON
LED Operation
OFF
LED flashes at a cycle of 5.6 Hz
A053171E10
(c) Low power mode:
(1) If a garage door opener switch is held for 100
seconds or more, the garage door opener will
enter low power mode to economize on power
consumption. When the garage door opener
has entered low power mode, the LED turns
off.
GD–6
GARAGE DOOR OPENER – GARAGE DOOR OPENER SYSTEM
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT GARAGE DOOR OPENER
(a) Press each switch and check that the red LED turns
on. If one or more of the switches does not turn on
the LED, confirm normal operation of the fuse and
wire harness. If the fuse and wire harness are
malfunctioning, replace them. If not, replace the
garage door opener.
2.
INSPECT GARAGE DOOR OPENER REGISTRATION
AND TRANSMITTING
HINT:
Use the KENTMORE home link tester and a tester
transmitter for this test. First erase the customer's
transmitter code(s), and then register the tester
transmitter code.
(a) Check if the tester transmitter code was
successfully registered.
HINT:
If the code cannot be registered, replace the garage
door opener.
LED
Press One of
These Switches
B075996E01
Press
Original Transmitter
B075997E01
(b) Press the garage door opener switch that was
registered to the tester transmitter. Check if the
home link tester's green LED illuminates.
HINT:
If the green LED does not illuminate, replace the
garage door opener.
(c) After finishing the inspection, reregister the
customer's transmitter code(s) if the original
transmitters are available.
GD
Press
Home Link Tester
B075998E01
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
HB–1
HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
1.
Lever
A083545E01
PRECAUTIONS FOR INSPECTING HYBRID BATTERY
SYSTEM
(a) Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take
safety precautions to prevent electrical shocks, such
as wearing insulated gloves and removing the
service plug grip (see page IN-5). After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent
other technicians from reconnecting it while you are
servicing the high-voltage system.
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause a
malfunction. Therefore, do not turn the power
switch ON (READY) unless instructed by the
repair manual.
(b) After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at
least 5 minutes before touching any of the highvoltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the
high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
(c) Since liquid leakage may occur, wear protective
goggles when checking inside the HV battery.
(d) Wear insulated gloves, turn the power switch OFF,
and disconnect the negative terminal of the auxiliary
battery before touching any of the orange-colored
wires of the high-voltage system.
(e) Turn the power switch OFF before performing a
resistance check.
(f) Turn the power switch OFF before disconnecting or
reconnecting any connector.
(g) To install the service plug grip, the lever must be
flipped and locked downward. Once it is locked in
place, it turns the interlock switch ON. Make sure to
lock it securely because if you leave it unlocked, the
system will output a DTC related to the interlock
switch system.
Lock
Lever
A089219E03
HB
HB–2
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
2.
System Name
See Page
Power Window Control System
IN-32
3.
HB
NOTICE FOR INITIALIZATION
When disconnecting the cable from the negative (-)
battery terminal, initialize the following system after the
cable is reconnected.
NOTICE FOR HYBRID SYSTEM ACTIVATION
• When the warning light is illuminated or the battery
has been disconnected and reconnected, pressing
the power switch may not start the system on the first
attempt. If so, press the power switch again.
• With the power switch's power mode changed to ON
(IG), disconnect the battery. If the key is not in the key
slot during reconnection, DTC B2799 may be output.
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
HB–3
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
*: Use the intelligent tester.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS
NEXT
3
CONNECT INTELLIGENT TESTER TO DLC3*
HINT:
If the display indicates a communication fault in the tester,
inspect the DLC3.
NEXT
4
CHECK AND RECORD DTC AND FREEZE FRAME DATA*
(a) Refer to the the DTC CHECK / CLEAR (see page HB17).
HINT:
If a DTC related to the CAN communication system
malfunction is output, first troubleshoot and repair the
CAN communication system (see page CA-6).
NEXT
5
CLEAR DTC*
(a) Refer to the the DTC CHECK / CLEAR (see page HB17).
NEXT
6
PROBLEM SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION
(a) When a malfunction does not occur, go to A.
(b) When a malfunction occurs, go to B.
B
A
Go to step 8
HB
HB–4
7
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
SYMPTOM SIMULATION
NEXT
8
CHECK DTC*
(a) Refer to the the DTC CHECK / CLEAR (see page HB17).
NEXT
9
DTC CHART
(a) Refer to the the DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE
CHART (see page HB-23).
NEXT
10
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
NEXT
11
IDENTIFICATION OF PROBLEM
NEXT
HB
12
ADJUSTMENT AND/OR REPAIR
NEXT
13
NEXT
END
CONFIRMATION TEST
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
HB–5
DEFINITION OF TERMS
1.
DEFINITION OF TERMS
Term
Definition
Duration
The minimum time that the battery ECU must sense a continuous
deviation in the monitored value(s) before setting a DTC. This timing
begins after the "typical enabling conditions" are met
Frequency of operation
The number of times that the battery ECU checks for malfunction per
driving cycle
"Once per driving cycle" means that the battery ECU detects
malfunction only one time during a single driving cycle
"Continuous" means that the battery ECU detects malfunction every
time when enabling condition is met
MIL operation
MIL illumination timing after a defect is detected
"Immediate" means that the battery ECU illuminates the MIL the
instant the battery ECU determines that there is malfunction
"2 driving cycles" means that the battery ECU illuminates the MIL if
the same malfunction is detected again in the 2nd driving cycle
Monitor description
Description of what the battery ECU monitors and how it detects
malfunction (monitoring purpose and its details)
Related DTCs
A group of DTCs that is classified by a system and a troubleshooting
procedure
Required sensor/components
The sensors and components that are used by the battery ECU to
detect malfunction
Sequence of operation
The priority order that is applied to monitoring, if multiple sensors and
components are used to detect the malfunction
While another sensor is being monitored, the next sensor or
component will not be monitored until the previous monitoring has
concluded
Typical enabling condition
Preconditions that allow the battery ECU to detect malfunction
With all preconditions satisfied, the battery ECU sets the DTC when
the monitored value(s) exceeds the malfunction threshold(s)
Typical malfunction thresholds
Beyond this value, the battery ECU will conclude that there is
malfunction and set a DTC
HB
HB–6
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
HV BATTERY ASSEMBLY
ENGINE ROOM RELAY BLOCK
- BATT FAN FUSE
- HEV FUSE
MULTI-INFORMATION DISPLAY
COMBINATION METER ECU
GATEWAY ECU
HB
HYBRID VEHICLE
CONTROL ECU
ECM
DLC3
A/C AMPLIFIER
C115885E01
HB–7
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
BATTERY BLOWER
VENTILATOR INNER DUCT
NO. 1 BATTERY BLOWER RELAY
NO. 2 QUARTER VENT DUCT INNER
QUARTER
VENT DUCT
HV BATTERY ASSEMBLY
NO. 2 QUARTER VENT DUCT
BATTERY BLOWER MOTOR CONTROLLER
NO. 2 FRAME WIRE (BUSBAR MODULE)
NO. 2 MAIN BATTERY CABLE
INTAKE AIR
TEMPERATURE
SENSOR
BATTERY TEMPERATURE
SENSOR 1
BATTERY MODULE
BATTERY CURRENT
SENSOR
HB
MAIN BATTERY CABLE
JUNCTION BLOCK ASSEMBLY
(BUSBAR MODULE)
BATTERY TEMPERATURE SENSOR 2
JUNCTION BLOCK ASSEMBLY
(BUSBAR MODULE)
BATTERY ECU
BATTERY PLUG
SERVICE PLUG GRIP (INCLUDES HIGH VOLTAGE FUSE)
BATTERY TEMPERATURE SENSOR 3
C115886E01
HB–8
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
Battery ECU
HEV
AM
A
IGCT
IGCT
HV Battery Assembly
VBB14
VBB13
VBB11
Hybrid Vehicle Control ECU
VBB10
MREL
Service
Plug Grip
IG2
AM2
IGN
IG2
Power Source
Control ECU
VBB8
VBB1
AM2
HB
High Voltage
VBB9
IG2D
GBB0
P/I
B
FCTL1
BATT FAN
MAIN
No. 1 Battery
Blower
CANH
CAN Communication
Auxiliary Battery
CANL
A133089E01
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
HB–9
Battery Temperature Sensor 1
TB1
GB1
Battery Temperature Sensor 2
Battery Blower
VM
TB2
GB2
Battery Temperature Sensor 3
TB3
+B
VM
SI
GB3
SI
Intake Air Temperature Sensor
GND
Battery Blower
Motor Controller
GND
TC1
GC1
HB
C115883E01
HB–10
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
VIB
IB
GIB
Hybrid Vehicle Control ECU
System Main
B
No. 3
(-)
CON3
Battery Current Sensor
System Main
No. 1
CON1
System Main Resistor
System Main
HB
A
No. 2
(+)
CON2
C115884E01
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
HB–11
Communication System Diagram
Hybrid Vehicle
Control ECU
ECM
Battery ECU
A/C Amplifier
Gateway ECU
: CAN
: BEAN
A081780E01
HB
HB–12
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
HB
OUTLINE
The principal role of the hybrid battery system is to
monitor the condition of the HV battery assembly through
the use of the battery ECU and transmit this information
to the hybrid vehicle control ECU. Furthermore, this
system controls the battery blower motor controller in
order to maintain a proper temperature in the HV battery
assembly.
The battery ECU uses the CAN (Controller Area
Network) to maintain communication with the following
devices: the hybrid vehicle control ECU, ECM, and A/C
amplifier.*
HINT:
*: Because it the battery ECU connected to the BEAN
(Body Electronics Area Network), data is transmitted via
the gateway ECU.
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
System Diagram
HB–13
: CAN
: BEAN
Battery ECU
Battery Current
Sensor
Battery Blower
Motor Controller
CPU
Hybrid Vehicle
Control ECU
HV Battery
Assembly
ECM
- Temperature
Sensor
Voltage
Detection
Circuit
Gateway ECU
- Voltage
Fault Current
Detection
Circuit
A/C Amplifier
HB
C115881E01
2.
CONTROL DESCRIPTION
(a) HV battery assembly management and fail-safe
function.
(1) When the vehicle is accelerated, the battery
assembly is discharged. When the vehicle is
decelerated, the battery assembly is charged by
converting brake energy. The battery ECU
calculates SOC (state of charge) of the HV
battery based on voltage, current, and
temperature, and then sends the results to the
hybrid vehicle control ECU. As a result, charge
and discharge control is performed in the hybrid
vehicle control ECU depending on the SOC.
HB–14
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
(2) If a malfunction occurs, the battery ECU
performs a fail-safe function and protects the HV
battery assembly in accordance with the extent
of the malfunction.
(b) Battery blower motor control.
(1) To control an increase in the temperature of the
HV battery assembly while the vehicle is being
driven, the battery ECU determines and controls
the operating mode of the battery blower in
accordance with the temperature of the HV
battery assembly.
(c) MIL illumination control.
(1) If the battery ECU detects a malfunction that
affects the exhaust gas emissions, it will transmit
an MIL illumination request to the hybrid vehicle
control ECU. (The battery ECU does not directly
illuminate the MIL.)
HB
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
HB–15
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT
PROBLEMS
1.
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
(a) Perform a simulation test (see page IN-36).
(1) In the simulation test, reproduce the driving
condition when the trouble occurred according to
the customer's comments and freeze frame data
recorded with DTCs.
(b) Check the connector(s) and terminal(s) (see page
IN-45).
(c) Wiggle the harness and connector(s) (see page IN45).
HB
HB–16
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
CHECK BATTERY ECU
Vehicle Rear
B11
Vehicle Front
B13
B12
A090442E01
(a) Measure the voltage of the battery ECU connector.
HINT:
Each ECU terminal's standard voltage is shown in
the table below.
In the table, first follow the information under
"Condition". Look under "Symbols (Terminal No.)"
for the terminals to be inspected. The standard
voltage between the terminals is shown under
"Specified Condition".
Use the illustration above as a reference for the
ECU terminals.
HB
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
AM (B11-1) - GND (B1112)
G - W-B
Auxiliary battery (for
measuring battery voltage
and for battery ECU
memory)
Always
9 to 14 V
IGCT (B11-2) - GND (B1112)
L - W-B
Control signal
Power switch ON
(READY)
9 to 14 V
VM (B11-9) - GND (B1112)
V - W-B
Battery blower motor
monitoring signal
Battery blower motor
mode 1 actuation (at low
speed)
10 to 14 V
VM (B11-9) - GND (B1112)
V - W-B
Battery blower motor
monitoring signal
Battery blower motor
mode 6 actuation (at high
speed)
2 to 6 V
HB–17
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
FCTL1 (B11-10) - GND
(B11-12)
BR - W-B
No. 1 battery blower relay
Battery blower motor
actuation
Below 1 V
IG2 (B11-13) - GND (B1112)
O - W-B
IG signal
Power switch ON (IG)
9 to 14 V
CANH (B11-18) - GND
(B11-12)
B - W-B
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Power switch ON (IG)
Pulse generation
(See waveform 1)
CANL (B11-19) - GND
(B11-12)
W - W-B
LOW-level CAN bus line
Power switch ON (IG)
Pulse generation
(See waveform 2)
SI (B11-24) - GND (B1112)
Y - W-B
Battery blower motor
actuation signal
Battery blower motor
modes 1 to 6 actuation
Pulse generation
(See waveform 3)
TB1 (B13-1) - GB1 (B132)
W-W
HV battery temperature
sensor 1
HV battery temperature:
-40 to 90°C (-40 to 194°F)
4.8 to 1.0 V
TB2 (B13-3) - GB2 (B134)
B-B
HV battery temperature
sensor 2
HV battery temperature:
-40 to 90°C (-40 to 194°F)
4.8 to 1.0 V
TB3 (B13-5) - GB3 (B136)
L-L
HV battery temperature
sensor 3
HV battery temperature:
-40 to 90°C (-40 to 194°F)
4.8 to 1.0 V
TC1 (B13-9) - GC1 (B1310)
G-G
Intake air temperature
sensor
Intake air temperature:
-40 to 90°C (-40 to 194°F)
4.8 to 1.0 V
VIB (B13-15) - GIB (B1314)
-
Power source of battery
current sensor (a specific
voltage)
Power switch ON (IG)
4.5 to 5.5 V
IB (B13-16) - GIB (B13-14)
-
Battery current sensor
Power switch ON
(READY)
0.5 to 4.5 V
GND (B11-12) - Body
ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always (resistance check)
Below 6 Ω
(b) Using an oscilloscope, check the waveform 1.
Waveform 1 (HIGH-level CAN bus line)
Item
Content
Symbols (Terminal No.)
CANH (B11-18) - GND (B11-12)
Tool Setting
1 V/Div., 2 µsec./Div.
Condition
Power switch ON (IG)
GND
HINT:
The waveform varies depending on the contents of
the communication.
A093177E01
(c) Using an oscilloscope, check the waveform 2.
Waveform 2 (LOW-level CAN bus line)
GND
A093178E01
Item
Content
Symbols (Terminal No.)
CANL (B11-19) - GND (B11-12)
Tool Setting
1 V/Div., 2 µsec./Div.
Condition
Power switch ON (IG)
HINT:
The waveform varies depending on the contents of
the communication.
HB
HB–18
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
(d) Using an oscilloscope, check the waveform 3.
Waveform 3 (Battery blower motor actuation
signal)
A
GND
B
Item
Content
Symbols (Terminal No.)
SI (B11-24) - GND (B11-12)
Tool Setting
1 V/Div., 50 µsec./Div.
Condition
During vehicle stop
HINT:
Amplitude A and B in the diagram vary by mode.
A093179E01
A
B
1
44.4 µsec.
155.6 µsec.
2
44.4 µsec.
155.6 µsec.
3
51.6 µsec.
148.4 µsec.
4
59.0 µsec.
141.0 µsec.
5
59.0 µsec.
141.0 µsec.
6
146.4 µsec.
53.6 µsec.
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
Combination Meter
1.
Master Warning Light
Multi-information Display
HB
Mode
DESCRIPTION
• The battery ECU has a self-diagnosis system. If the
computer, HV battery system or the components are
not working properly, the ECU carries out a diagnosis
to detect the malfunction, and illuminates the master
warning light in the combination meter together with
the HV system warning indicator on the multiinformation display.
HINT:
The master warning light illuminates when the HV
battery system fails and it blinks when in inspection
mode.
HV System Warning
A131410E01
• When troubleshooting OBD II vehicles, the only
difference from the usual troubleshooting procedure is
that you need to connect the OBD II scan tool
(complying with ISO 15031-4) or the intelligent tester
to the vehicle, and read various data output from the
vehicle's ECUs.
FI00534E01
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
• OBD II regulations require that the vehicle's on-board
computer illuminate the MIL in the instrument panel
when the computer detects a malfunction in: 1) the
emission control systems/components, or 2) the
powertrain control components (which affect vehicle
emissions), or 3) the computers. In addition, the
applicable Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs)
prescribed by SAE J2012 are recorded in the battery
ECU memory (see page HB-23).
If the malfunction does not recur in 3 consecutive trips,
the MIL will turn off automatically. However the DTCs
remain recorded in the battery ECU memory.
• To check the DTCs, connect the intelligent tester to
the Data Link Connector 3 (DLC3) with the CAN
vehicle interface module (CAN VIM). Or, connect the
OBD II scan tool to the DLC3. The intelligent tester or
OBD II scan tool also enables you to erase DTCs and
check the freeze frame data and various forms of the
HV battery system data (for operating instructions,
refer to their respective instruction manuals). The
DTCs include SAE controlled codes and
manufacturer controlled codes. SAE controlled codes
must be set as prescribed by the SAE, while
manufacturer controlled codes can be set by a
manufacturer within the prescribed limits (see page
HB-23).
• Freeze frame data:
The freeze frame data records the driving condition
when a malfunction is detected. When
troubleshooting, it can help determine if the vehicle
was moving forward, braking, stationary, or moving in
reverse.
Intelligent Tester
DLC3
CAN VIM
C118371E01
2.
DLC3
CG
SG
CANH SIL
CHECK DLC3
The battery ECU uses the ISO 15765-4. The terminal
arrangement of the DLC3 complies with ISO 15031-3
and matches the ISO 15765-4 format.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 1213141516
CANL
Symbols (Terminal No.)
BAT
HB–19
A082779E81
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
SIL (7) - SG (5)
Bus "+" line
During transmission
Pulse generation
CG (4) - Body ground
Chassis ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
SG (5) - Body ground
Signal ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
BAT (16) - Body ground
Battery positive
Always
9 to 14 V
CANH (6) - CANL (14)
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Ignition switch OFF
54 to 69 Ω
CANH (6) - Battery positive
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Ignition switch OFF
1 MΩ or higher
CANH (6) - CG (4)
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Ignition switch OFF
200 Ω or higher
CANL (14) - Battery positive
LOW-level CAN bus line
Ignition switch OFF
1 MΩ or higher
CANL (14) - CG (4)
LOW-level CAN bus line
Ignition switch OFF
200 Ω or higher
HB
HB–20
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
3.
4.
HB
HINT:
*: Before measuring the resistance, leave the vehicle as
is for at least 1 minute and do not operate the ignition
switch, other switches or doors.
If the result is not as specified, the DLC3 may have a
malfunction. Repair or replace the harness and
connector.
HINT:
Connect the cable of the intelligent tester or the OBD II
scan tool to the DLC3, turn the power switch ON (IG)
and attempt to use the tester. If the display indicates
UNABLE TO CONNECT TO VEHICLE has occurred,
there is a problem either with the vehicle or with the
tester.
• If communication is normal when the tester or scan
tool is connected to another vehicle, inspect the DLC3
on the original vehicle.
• If communication is still not possible when the tester
or scan tool is connected to another vehicle, the
problem is probably in the tester or scan tool itself, so
consult the Service Department listed in its instruction
manual.
INSPECT AUXILIARY BATTERY
(a) Measure the voltage of the auxiliary battery.
Standard voltage:
11 to 14 V
(b) Inspect the auxiliary battery, fuses, fusible links,
wiring harness, connectors and ground.
CHECK MIL
(a) The MIL illuminates when the power switch is turned
ON (IG) and the "READY" light is OFF.
If the MIL is not illuminated, troubleshoot the MIL
circuit (see page ES-428).
FI00534E01
(b) When the "READY" light turns illuminated, the MIL
should turn off.
If the MIL remains on, the diagnosis system has
detected a malfunction or abnormality in the system.
A087700E01
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
HB–21
DTC CHECK / CLEAR
1.
CHECK DTC (HV BATTERY)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and the tester ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/
MOBD / HV BATTERY / DTC INFO / TROUBLE
CODES.
(d) Confirm the details of the DTCs (see page HB-23).
Intelligent Tester
DLC3
CAN VIM
C118371E01
2.
HV_ECU
A093189E01
CHECK FREEZE FRAME DATA
(a) If a DTC is present, select that DTC in order to
display its freeze frame data.
(b) Read freeze frame data recorded when the DTC
was set.
3. CHECK DTC (SYSTEMS OTHER THAN HV BATTERY)
HINT:
The battery ECU maintains mutual communication with
the computers, including the ECM, hybrid vehicle control
ECU and others. Therefore, if the battery ECU outputs a
warning, it is necessary to check and record the DTCs of
all the systems.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and the tester ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/
MOBD / CODES (All).
(d) If DTCs output, check the relevant system.
HINT:
If DTCs for the CAN communication system are present in
addition to other DTCs, first troubleshoot and repair any
malfunctions in the CAN communication (see page CA-6).
4. CLEAR DTC
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and the tester ON.
(c) Check that the shift position is in the P position.
(d) Clear DTCs and freeze frame data.
(1) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/
MOBD / HV BATTERY / DTC INFO / CLEAR
CODES.
(2) Press YES.
HB
HB–22
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
FREEZE FRAME DATA
1.
FREEZE FRAME DATA
HINT:
The freeze frame data records the operating conditions
of the HV battery system and components when the DTC
was set. It is used for estimating or simulating the
condition of the vehicle when a malfunction occurred.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and the tester ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/
MOBD / HV BATTERY / DTC INFO / TROUBLE
CODES.
(d) Select a DTC in order to display its freeze frame
data.
(e) Check the freeze frame data of the DTC that has
been detected.
Freeze frame data
HB
Intelligent Tester Display
Measurement Item/Range
Suspected Vehicle Status
When Malfunction Occurs
BATTERY SOC
State of charge (SOC) of HV battery
Min.: 0%, Max: 100%
-
DELTA SOC
SOC variance/
Min.: 0%, Max.: 100%
Difference between maximum and minimum
values of SOC at every battery block
IB BATTERY
Current value of battery pack/
Min.: -327.68 A, Max.: 327.67 A
Charging/discharging condition of HV battery
• Discharging amperage indicated by a
positive value
• Charging amperage indicated by a
negative value
BATT INSIDE AIR
Temperature of intake ambient air to battery
pack/
Min.: -327.68°C, Max.: 327.67°C
-
VMF FAN VOLTAGE
Battery blower motor voltage/
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 25.4 V
Actuation condition of battery blower motor
AUX. BATT V
Auxiliary battery voltage/
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 25.4 V
Condition of auxiliary battery
WIN
Charge wattage of HV battery/
Min.: -64 kW, Max.: 0 kW
Charge control wattage which is sent from
battery ECU to hybrid vehicle control ECU
WOUT
Discharge wattage of HV battery/
Min.: 0 kW, Max.: 63.5 kW
Discharge control wattage which is sent from
battery ECU to hybrid vehicle control ECU
COOLING FAN SPD
Battery blower motor drive mode/
Min.: 0, Max.: 6
Stopped: 0
Low to high speed actuation: 1 to 6
ECU CTRL MODE
ECU control mode/
Min.: 0, Max.: 4
Operating condition of HV battery
SBLW RQST
Battery blower motor stop control request
(standby blower)
-
BATT TEMP 1 to 3
Temperature of HV battery/
Min.: -327.68°C, Max.: 327.67°C
-
V1 to V14 BATT BLOCK
Battery block voltage/
Min.: -327.68 V, Max.: 327.67 V
Voltage variance among battery blocks
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
HB–23
FAIL-SAFE CHART
1.
FAIL-SAFE CHART
DTC No.
Detection Item
Driving Condition
P0560
System Voltage
Turns on READY light and drives normally
P0A1F
Battery Energy Control Module
Turns on READY light and drives in fail-safe
mode
P0A7F
Hybrid Battery Pack Deterioration
Turns on READY light and drives normally
P0A80
Replace Hybrid Battery Pack
Turns on READY light and drives normally
P0A81
Hybrid Battery Pack Cooling Fan 1
Turns on READY light and drives normally
P0A82
Hybrid Battery Pack Cooling Fan 1
Performance or Stuck OFF
Turns on READY light and drives normally
P0A84
Hybrid Battery Pack Cooling Fan 1 Control
Circuit Low
Turns on READY light and drives normally
P0A85
Hybrid Battery Pack Cooling Fan 1 Control
Circuit High
Turns on READY light and drives normally
P0A95
High Voltage Fuse
Turns on READY light and drives in fail-safe
mode (while the engine is running)
Turns off READY light and stops the HV
control system (while the engine stops)
P0A9C
Hybrid Battery Temperature Sensor "A"
Range/Performance
Turns on READY light and drives normally
P0A9D
Hybrid Battery Temperature Sensor "A"
Circuit Low
Turns on READY light and drives normally
P0A9E
Hybrid Battery Temperature Sensor "A"
Circuit High
Turns on READY light and drives normally
P0AAC
Hybrid Battery Pack Air Temperature Sensor
"A" Circuit
Turns on READY light and drives normally
P0ABF
Hybrid Battery Pack Current Sensor Circuit
Turns on READY light and drives normally
P0AC0
Hybrid Battery Pack Current Sensor Circuit
Range/Performance
Turns on READY light and drives normally
P0AC1
Hybrid Battery Pack Current Sensor Circuit
Low
Turns on READY light and drives normally
P0AC2
Hybrid Battery Pack Current Sensor Circuit
High
Turns on READY light and drives normally
P0AFA
Hybrid Battery System Voltage
Turns on READY light and drives normally
P3011
Battery Block 1 Becomes Weak
Turns on READY light and drives in fail-safe
mode
P3012
Battery Block 2 Becomes Weak
Turns on READY light and drives in fail-safe
mode
P3013
Battery Block 3 Becomes Weak
Turns on READY light and drives in fail-safe
mode
P3014
Battery Block 4 Becomes Weak
Turns on READY light and drives in fail-safe
mode
P3015
Battery Block 5 Becomes Weak
Turns on READY light and drives in fail-safe
mode
P3016
Battery Block 6 Becomes Weak
Turns on READY light and drives in fail-safe
mode
P3017
Battery Block 7 Becomes Weak
Turns on READY light and drives in fail-safe
mode
P3018
Battery Block 8 Becomes Weak
Turns on READY light and drives in fail-safe
mode
P3019
Battery Block 9 Becomes Weak
Turns on READY light and drives in fail-safe
mode
P3020
Battery Block 10 Becomes Weak
Turns on READY light and drives in fail-safe
mode
P3021
Battery Block 11 Becomes Weak
Turns on READY light and drives in fail-safe
mode
HB
HB–24
HB
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
DTC No.
Detection Item
Driving Condition
P3022
Battery Block 12 Becomes Weak
Turns on READY light and drives in fail-safe
mode
P3023
Battery Block 13 Becomes Weak
Turns on READY light and drives in fail-safe
mode
P3024
Battery Block 14 Becomes Weak
Turns on READY light and drives in fail-safe
mode
U0100
Lost Communication with ECM/PCM "A"
Turns on READY light and drives normally
U0293
Lost Communication with HV ECU
Turns on READY light and drives normally
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
HB–25
DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST
1.
READ DATA LIST
NOTICE:
• The DATA LIST values may vary significantly if
there are slight differences in measurement,
differences in the environment in which the
measurements are obtained, or the aging of the
vehicle. Thus, definite standards or judgment
values are unavailable. There may be a
malfunction even if a measured value is within the
reference range.
• In the event of intricate symptoms, collect sample
data from another vehicle of the same model
operating under identical conditions, in order to
reach an overall judgment by comparing all the
items of the DATA LIST.
HINT:
Using the intelligent tester's DATA LIST allows switch,
sensor, actuator and other item values to be read without
removing any parts. Reading the DATA LIST as the first
step of troubleshooting is one method to shorten
diagnostic time.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and the tester ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/
MOBD / HV BATTERY / DATA LIST.
(d) Check the results by referring to the following table.
Intelligent Tester Display
Measurement Item/Range
(Display)
Reference Range
Diagnostic Note
MIL status
MIL status/
ON or OFF
MIL ON: ON
Constant ON:
Repair in accordance with
detected DTCs
DRIVING MILEAGE
Accumulated driving mileage
after the malfunction occurrence/
Min.: 0 km, Max.: 65,535 km
-
-
BATTERY SOC
Battery state of charge/
Min.: 0%, Max: 100%
Always: 0 to 100%
-
DELTA SOC
Difference between maximum
and minimum values of SOC/
Min.: 0%, Max.: 100%
READY light ON, engine stopped
and no electrical load:
0 to 60%
-
IB BATTERY
Current value of battery pack/
Min.: -327.68 A, Max.: 327.67 A
•
Soon after a full-load
acceleration with the engine
stopped:
Maximum 140 A (room
temperature)
When shifting into N position,
1 second has elapsed after
engine started with P
position, engine stopped,
head light ON, A/C fan high,
and READY light ON:
Maximum 30 A
-
•
BATT INSIDE AIR
Temperature of intake ambient air
to battery pack/
Min.: -327.68°C, Max.: 327.67°C
Undisturbed for 1 day:
Same as ambient air temperature
-
VMF FAN VOLTAGE
Battery blower motor monitoring
voltage/
Min.: -25.6 V, Max.: 25.4 V
Fan mode 1 with READY light ON
and P position:
9.5 to 11.5 V
-
HB
HB–26
HB
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
Intelligent Tester Display
Measurement Item/Range
(Display)
Reference Range
Diagnostic Note
AUX. BATT V
Auxiliary battery voltage/
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 25.4 V
Equivalent to auxiliary battery
voltage
-
WIN
Charge control wattage which is
sent from battery ECU to hybrid
vehicle control ECU/
Min.: -64 kW, Max.: 0 kW
-25 kW or more
-
WOUT
Discharge control wattage which
is sent from battery ECU to hybrid
vehicle control ECU/
Min.: 0 kW, Max.: 63.5 kW
21 kW or less
-
COOLING FAN SPD
Battery blower motor actuation
mode/
Min.: 0, Max.: 6
Stopped: 0
Low to high speed actuation: 1 to
6
-
ECU CTRL MODE
ECU control mode/
Min.: 0, Max.: 4
-
-
SBLW RQST
Battery blower motor stop control
request (standby blower)
ON/OFF
-
BATT TEMP 1 to 3
Temperature of HV battery/
Min.: -327.68°C, Max.: 327.67°C
Undisturbed for 1 day:
Same as ambient air temperature
-
NUM OF BATT
The number of battery blocks/
Min.: 0, Max.: 255
Always: 14
-
BAT BLOCK MIN V
Battery block minimum voltage/
Min.: -327.68 V, Max.: 327.67 V
SOC 50 to 60%: 12 V or more
-
MIN BAT BLOCK #
Battery block number with
minimum voltage
One of numbers 0 to 13
-
BAT BLOCK MAX V
Battery block maximum voltage/
Min.: -327.68 V, Max.: 327.67 V
SOC 55 to 60%: 23 V or less
-
MAX BAT BLOCK #
Battery block number with
maximum voltage
One of numbers 0 to 13
-
V1 to V14 BATT BLOCK
Battery block voltage/
Min.: -327.68 V, Max.: 327.67 V
SOC 60%: 12 to 20 V
-
1 to 14 INTNL RESIST
Internal resistance of each battery
block/
Min.: 0 Ω, Max.: 0.255 Ω
Always: 0.01 to 0.1 Ω
-
REGULATION
Compliance regulation
OBD2 (CARB)
-
#CODES
The number of emission related
powertrain DTCs/
Min.: 0, Max.: 127
-
-
DTC
The number of stored DTCs/
Min.: 0, Max.: 255
-
-
2.
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST
NOTICE:
Beware that if the connector to the intelligent tester
becomes disconnected or a communication error
occurs during the ACTIVE TEST, the vehicle could
become inoperative (READY light OFF).
HINT:
Performing an ACTIVE TEST using the intelligent tester
enables components including the relay, VSV, and
actuator, to be operated without removing any parts.
Performing an ACTIVE TEST as the first step of
troubleshooting is one method to shorten diagnostic
time.
It is possible to display items in the DATA LIST during the
ACTIVE TEST.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
HB–27
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and the tester ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/
MOBD / HV BATTERY / ACTIVE TEST.
(d) Perform the ACTIVE TEST according to the display
on the tester.
Intelligent Tester Display
Purpose
Test Details
Test Condition
COOLING FAN SPD
To check the operation and the
speed of the battery blower motor
Stops the battery blower motor in
mode 0 or operates it in modes 1
to 6
Disabled when a DTC is detected
HB
HB–28
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
HINT:
• *1: "Comes on" means that the MIL is illuminated. "-"
means that the MIL is not illuminated.
• *2: "Comes on" means that the master warning light is
illuminated.
• *3: Warning shown on the multi-information display.
HB
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
MIL
Master
Warning Light
Warning
Memory
See page
P0560
System Voltage
- Wire harness
or connector
- HEV fuse
- Battery ECU
Comes on
Comes on
HV system
DTC Stored
HB-27
P0A1F
Battery Energy
Control Module
Battery ECU
Comes on
Comes on
HV system
DTC Stored
HB-31
P0A7F
Hybrid Battery
Pack
Deterioration
- HV battery
assembly
- Battery ECU
Comes on
Comes on
HV system
DTC Stored
HB-33
P0A80
Replace Hybrid
Battery Pack
- HV battery
assembly
- Battery ECU
Comes on
Comes on
HV system
DTC Stored
HB-35
P0A81
Hybrid Battery
Pack Cooling
Fan 1
- Quarter vent
duct (blower
motor
controller)
- Battery ECU
-
Comes on
HV system
DTC Stored
HB-37
P0A82
Hybrid Battery
Pack Cooling
Fan 1
Performance or
Stuck OFF
- Quarter vent
duct
- No. 2 quarter
vent duct
- No. 2 quarter
vent duct inner
- Ventilator
inner duct
- Battery blower
- Battery ECU
-
Comes on
HV system
DTC Stored
HB-39
P0A84
Hybrid Battery
Pack Cooling
Fan 1 Control
Circuit Low
- Wire harness
or connector
- BATT FAN
fuse
- No. 1 battery
blower relay
- Battery blower
- Quarter vent
duct (blower
motor
controller)
- Battery ECU
-
Comes on
HV system
DTC Stored
HB-41
P0A85
Hybrid Battery
Pack Cooling
Fan 1 Control
Circuit High
- Wire harness
or connector
- BATT FAN
fuse
- No. 1 battery
blower relay
- Battery blower
- Quarter vent
duct (blower
motor
controller)
- Battery ECU
-
Comes on
HV system
DTC Stored
HB-41
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
MIL
Master
Warning Light
Warning
Memory
HB–29
See page
P0A95
High Voltage
Fuse
- High voltage
fuse
- Service plug
grip
- Battery plug
- Battery ECU
-
Comes on
HV system
DTC Stored
HB-52
P0A9C
Hybrid Battery
Temperature
Sensor "A"
- HV battery
assembly
(battery
temperature
sensor)
- Battery ECU
Comes on
Comes on
HV system
DTC Stored
HB-55
P0A9D
Hybrid Battery
Temperature
Sensor "A"
Circuit Low
- HV battery
assembly
(battery
temperature
sensor)
- Battery ECU
Comes on
Comes on
HV system
DTC Stored
HB-55
P0A9E
Hybrid Battery
Temperature
Sensor "A"
Circuit High
- HV battery
assembly
(battery
temperature
sensor)
- Battery ECU
Comes on
Comes on
HV system
DTC Stored
HB-55
P0AAC
Hybrid Battery
Pack Air
Temperature
Sensor "A"
Circuit
- HV battery
assembly
(intake air
temperature
sensor)
- Battery ECU
Comes on
Comes on
HV system
DTC Stored
HB-59
P0ABF
Hybrid Battery
Pack Current
Sensor Circuit
- HV battery
assembly (wire
harness or
connector)
- Battery
current sensor
- Battery ECU
Comes on
Comes on
HV system
DTC Stored
HB-62
P0AC0
Hybrid Battery
Pack Current
Sensor Circuit
Range/
Performance
- HV battery
assembly (wire
harness or
connector)
- Battery
current sensor
- Battery ECU
Comes on
Comes on
HV system
DTC Stored
HB-62
P0AC1
Hybrid Battery
Pack Current
Sensor Circuit
Low
- HV battery
assembly (wire
harness or
connector)
- Battery
current sensor
- Battery ECU
Comes on
Comes on
HV system
DTC Stored
HB-62
P0AC2
Hybrid Battery
Pack Current
Sensor Circuit
High
- HV battery
assembly (wire
harness or
connector)
- Battery
current sensor
- Battery ECU
Comes on
Comes on
HV system
DTC Stored
HB-62
HB
HB–30
HB
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
MIL
Master
Warning Light
Warning
Memory
See page
P0AFA
Hybrid Battery
System Voltage
Low
- Junction block
assembly
(busbar
module)
- No. 2 frame
wire (busbar
and wire
harness)
Battery ECU
Comes on
Comes on
HV system
DTC Stored
HB-67
P3011
Battery Block 1
Becomes Weak
- HV battery
assembly
- Battery ECU
Comes on
Comes on
HV system
DTC Stored
HB-72
P3012
Battery Block 2
Becomes Weak
- HV battery
assembly
- Battery ECU
Comes on
Comes on
HV system
DTC Stored
HB-72
P3013
Battery Block 3
Becomes Weak
- HV battery
assembly
- Battery ECU
Comes on
Comes on
HV system
DTC Stored
HB-72
P3014
Battery Block 4
Becomes Weak
- HV battery
assembly
- Battery ECU
Comes on
Comes on
HV system
DTC Stored
HB-72
P3015
Battery Block 5
Becomes Weak
- HV battery
assembly
- Battery ECU
Comes on
Comes on
HV system
DTC Stored
HB-72
P3016
Battery Block 6
Becomes Weak
- HV battery
assembly
- Battery ECU
Comes on
Comes on
HV system
DTC Stored
HB-72
P3017
Battery Block 7
Becomes Weak
- HV battery
assembly
- Battery ECU
Comes on
Comes on
HV system
DTC Stored
HB-72
P3018
Battery Block 8
Becomes Weak
- HV battery
assembly
- Battery ECU
Comes on
Comes on
HV system
DTC Stored
HB-72
P3019
Battery Block 9
Becomes Weak
- HV battery
assembly
- Battery ECU
Comes on
Comes on
HV system
DTC Stored
HB-72
P3020
Battery Block
10 Becomes
Weak
- HV battery
assembly
- Battery ECU
Comes on
Comes on
HV system
DTC Stored
HB-72
P3021
Battery Block
11 Becomes
Weak
- HV battery
assembly
- Battery ECU
Comes on
Comes on
HV system
DTC Stored
HB-72
P3022
Battery Block
12 Becomes
Weak
- HV battery
assembly
- Battery ECU
Comes on
Comes on
HV system
DTC Stored
HB-72
P3023
Battery Block
13 Becomes
Weak
- HV battery
assembly
- Battery ECU
Comes on
Comes on
HV system
DTC Stored
HB-72
P3024
Battery Block
14 Becomes
Weak
- HV battery
assembly
- Battery ECU
Comes on
Comes on
HV system
DTC Stored
HB-72
U0100
Lost
Communication
with ECM/PCM
"A"
CAN
communication
system
Comes on
Comes on
HV system
DTC Stored
HB-75
U0293
Lost
Communication
with HV ECU
CAN
communication
system
Comes on
Comes on
HV system
DTC Stored
HB-75
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
DTC
P0560
HB–31
System Voltage
DESCRIPTION
Battery power is constantly supplied to the AM terminal of the battery ECU for the purpose of maintaining
the DTCs and freeze frame data in memory. This voltage is supplied as a backup even if the power switch
is turned OFF.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0560
Open in auxiliary battery power supply system
while battery power is supplied to terminal
IGCT (1 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
HEV fuse
Battery ECU
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
If 1 or more seconds have elapsed with a voltage of 1 V or less at the AM terminal at the battery ECU, the
battery ECU will determine that malfunction has occurred in the back-up power supply system, illuminate
the MIL, and set a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0560: Battery ECU/Range check
Required sensors/components
Main: Back-up power source circuit
Sub: Battery ECU
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
1 second
MIL operation
Immediate after next power switch ON (IG)
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
HB
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Stand-by RAM back-up voltage
1 V or less
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Auxiliary battery voltage
9 to 14 V
HB–32
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Battery ECU
HEV
From Auxiliary Battery
AM
C118374E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FUSE (HEV)
(a) Remove the HEV fuse from the engine room relay block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the HEV fuse.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
(c) Reinstall the HEV fuse.
Engine Room Relay Block
NG
HB
HEV Fuse
C118372E01
OK
Go to step 3
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
2
HB–33
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (BATTERY ECU - AUXILIARY BATTERY)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
Positive Terminal
Disconnect the negative auxiliary battery terminal.
Disconnect the positive auxiliary battery terminal.
Remove the HEV fuse from the engine room relay block.
Disconnect the B11 battery ECU connector.
Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
B11-1 (AM) - HEV fuse terminal 2
Below 1 Ω
HEV fuse terminal 1 - Positive
auxiliary battery terminal
Below 1 Ω
NOTICE:
When taking a measurement with a tester, do not
apply excessive force to the tester probe to avoid
damaging the holder.
(f) Reconnect the battery ECU connector.
(g) Reinstall the HEV fuse.
(h) Reconnect the positive auxiliary battery terminal.
(i) Reconnect the negative auxiliary battery terminal.
Engine Room
Relay Block
NG
HEV Fuse
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
B11
Battery ECU
HB
AM
A131604E01
OK
CHECK AND REPAIR CONNECTOR CONNECTION
HB–34
3
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (BATTERY ECU - HEV FUSE)
(a) Disconnect the B11 battery ECU connector.
(b) Remove the HEV fuse from the engine room relay block.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
B11
Battery ECU
AM
Engine Room Relay Block
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
B11-1 (AM) or HEV fuse terminal 2 Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NOTICE:
When taking a measurement with a tester, do not
apply excessive force to the tester probe to avoid
damaging the holder.
(d) Reconnect the battery ECU connector.
(e) Reinstall the HEV fuse.
NG
HEV Fuse
A131605E01
HB
OK
REPLACE FUSE (HEV)
AFTER REPAIRING OR REPLACING
HARNESS AND CONNECTOR, REPLACE
FUSE (HEV)
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
DTC
P0A1F
HB–35
Battery Energy Control Module
DESCRIPTION
For the purpose of calculating the SOC (state of charge) of the HV battery and ensuring safety in the
event of a malfunction in the HV battery assembly, the battery ECU provides the following control
functions:
• SOC calculation
The battery ECU calculates the SOC by estimating the charging and discharging amperage and
monitoring other values.
• Cooling fan control
The battery ECU controls the battery blower in order to protect the HV battery assembly from heat that
is generated during charging and discharging. By maintaining a stable temperature, it promotes the
effective operation of the HV battery assembly.
• HV battery assembly malfunction monitoring
If the battery ECU detects a malfunction, it protects the HV battery assembly by limiting or stopping the
charging or discharging of the HV battery in accordance with the temperature or voltage of the HV
battery assembly.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A1F
Battery ECU internal error (1 trip detection
logic)
Battery ECU
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
If the battery ECU detects an internal malfunction in the ECU itself, it illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A1F: Battery ECU/Rationality
Required sensors/components
Battery ECU
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
Immediate or 1 driving cycle or 2 driving cycles
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Battery ECU
Abnormal
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Battery ECU
DTC P0A1F is not detected
HB
HB–36
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
REPLACE BATTERY ECU
NEXT
COMPLETED
HB
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
DTC
P0A7F
HB–37
Hybrid Battery Pack Deterioration
DESCRIPTION
Upper SOC control limit
Control region
Example of change in SOC
SOC
Time
Lower SOC control limit
Central SOC level
C115845E01
The battery ECU calculates the SOC (state of charge) of the HV battery by estimating the amperage that
flows into the HV battery and monitoring other values.
The battery ECU sends the calculated SOC to the hybrid vehicle control ECU. The hybrid vehicle control
ECU charges and discharges the HV battery depending on driving patterns based on the information sent
by the battery ECU.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A7F
When either condition below is met:
• Resistance of HV battery assembly is
higher than standard (1 trip detection
logic)
• When the capacity difference between
battery modules exceeds the specified
value (2 trip detection logic)
•
•
HV battery assembly
Battery ECU
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The battery ECU calculates the resistance of the HV battery through amperage and voltage, and uses this
resistance to determine the extent of deterioration of the HV battery. If the battery ECU detects that the
resistance of the HV battery has exceeded the standard, it determines that malfunction has occurred. In
addition, the battery ECU monitors the SOC, and if the difference between the maximum and minimum
SOC values exceeds the standard, it determines that malfunction has occurred. When either of the
malfunction detection conditions is met, the battery ECU illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A7F: HV battery/Rationality
Required sensors/components
Main: Battery voltage sensor inside battery ECU, battery current
sensor
Sub: Battery temperature sensor
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
Immediate or 2 driving cycles
Sequence of operation
None
HB
HB–38
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Either of the following condition
(1) or (2)
(1) Internal resistance
Exceeds the standard level
(2) The difference between the maximum SOC and the minimum SOC
Exceeds the standard level
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ DTC OUTPUT (DTC P0A1F IS OUTPUT)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and the tester ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV BATTERY / DTC INFO / TROUBLE CODES.
(d) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTC P0A1F is output
YES
NO
HB
REPLACE HV SUPPLY BATTERY ASSEMBLY
REPLACE BATTERY ECU
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
DTC
P0A80
HB–39
Replace Hybrid Battery Pack
DESCRIPTION
The HV battery assembly consists of nickel hydride batteries. Nickel hydride batteries do not require
external charging. The SOC (state of charge) of the HV battery is maintained at a constant voltage level
by the hybrid vehicle control ECU while the vehicle is being driven. In the HV battery assembly, 28
modules are connected in series, and each module has six 1.2 V cells that are connected in series. Thus,
the HV battery assembly contains a total of 168 cells which produce 201.6 V.
The battery ECU, which monitors two modules as a single battery block, detects the battery block voltage
at a total of 14 locations.
Battery Block
Battery Module
GBB0
VBB2
VBB13
VBB3
VBB1
VBB14
Battery ECU
C115846E01
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A80
Voltage difference between battery blocks is
higher than standard (2 trip detection logic)
•
•
HV battery assembly
Battery ECU
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The battery ECU, which monitors the voltage of the battery blocks, determines that malfunction has
occurred if a voltage difference between the battery blocks exceeds the standard. When the malfunction
detection condition is satisfied, the battery ECU illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A80: HV battery/Rationality
Required sensors/components
Main: Battery voltage sensor inside battery ECU
Sub: Battery current sensor, battery temperature sensor
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
HB
HB–40
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Battery voltage difference
Exceeds the standard level
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ DTC OUTPUT (DTC P0A1F IS OUTPUT)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and the tester ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV BATTERY / DTC INFO / TROUBLE CODES.
(d) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTC P0A1F is output
YES
NO
REPLACE HV SUPPLY BATTERY ASSEMBLY
HB
REPLACE BATTERY ECU
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
DTC
P0A81
HB–41
Hybrid Battery Pack Cooling Fan 1
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0A84 (see page HB-41).
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A81
Voltage at motor is out of predetermined
range in proportion to target control voltage (1
trip detection logic)
•
•
Quarter vent duct (blower motor
controller)
Battery ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0A84 (see page HB-42).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ DTC OUTPUT (DTC P0A1F IS OUTPUT)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and the tester ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV BATTERY / DTC INFO / TROUBLE CODES.
(d) Read DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
P0A81
A
P0A81 and P0A1F
B
P0A81 and P0A84
C
B
REPLACE BATTERY ECU
C
GO TO DTC P0A84 CHART
A
2
REPLACE QUARTER VENT DUCT (BATTERY BLOWER MOTOR CONTROLLER)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Replace the quarter vent duct (blower motor controller).
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG) and the tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV BATTERY / DTC INFO / CLEAR CODES.
(e) Perform a simulation test.
NEXT
3
READ DTC OUTPUT (DTC P0A81 IS OUTPUT AGAIN)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and the tester ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV BATTERY / DTC INFO / TROUBLE CODES.
HB
HB–42
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
(d) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTC P0A81 is output again
YES
NO
SYSTEM IS OK
HB
REPLACE BATTERY ECU
HB–43
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
DTC
P0A82
Hybrid Battery Pack Cooling Fan 1 Performance or Stuck OFF
DESCRIPTION
The cooling air flows into the inlet on the right of the rear seat and travels through an intake duct to the
battery blower on the right surface of the luggage compartment. Furthermore, the cooling air travels
through an intake duct (which connects the battery blower to the upper right surface of the HV battery
assembly) and flows to the HV battery assembly.
The cooling air flows from the top to the bottom between the HV battery modules. After it has cooled the
modules, it is discharged from the bottom right surface of the HV battery assembly.
The exhaust air travels through an exhaust duct on the right surface of the luggage compartment and is
discharged into the cabin as well as outside of the vehicle.
The battery ECU uses battery temperature sensors in order to detect the temperature of the HV battery
assembly. Based on the results of this detection, the battery ECU controls the battery blower. (Thus, the
battery blower starts when the HV battery temperature rises to a predetermined level.)
Ventilator Inner Duct
No. 2 Quarter Vent Duct Inner
Battery Blower
HV Battery Assembly
No. 2 Quarter Vent Duct
Quarter Vent Duct
Top
Flow of cooling air inside HV battery case
HB
Intake
: Cooling Air Flow
Bottom
Battery Module
Exhaust
A093182E01
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A82
Difference between estimated battery
temperature based on blower fan cooling
performance and actual temperature is
excessive (2 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
•
•
Quarter vent duct
No. 2 quarter vent duct
No. 2 quarter vent duct inner
Ventilator inner duct
Battery blower
Battery ECU
HB–44
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ DTC OUTPUT (DTC P0A1F IS OUTPUT)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and the tester ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV BATTERY / DTC INFO / TROUBLE CODES.
(d) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTC P0A1F is output
YES
REPLACE BATTERY ECU
NO
2
CHECK DUCT AND BLOWER
(a) Check the ducts and the blower listed below for
disconnection and damage. Also, check that they are not
clogged up with foreign substances.
(1) Quarter vent duct
(2) No. 2 quarter vent duct
(3) No. 2 quarter vent duct inner
(4) Ventilator inner duct
(5) Battery blower
NG
OK
HB
REPLACE BATTERY ECU
REMOVE FOREIGN SUBSTANCES OR
REPLACE AFFECTED PARTS
HB–45
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
DTC
P0A84
Hybrid Battery Pack Cooling Fan 1 Control Circuit Low
DTC
P0A85
Hybrid Battery Pack Cooling Fan 1 Control Circuit High
DESCRIPTION
The blower motor controller regulates the voltage of the battery blower. The blower motor controller has
fins made of aluminum. The exhaust air from the HV battery assembly that flows through the quarter vent
duct cools the blower motor controller, which is installed in the quarter vent duct.
The current flows from the FCTL1 terminal of the battery ECU to the relay coil of the No. 1 battery blower
relay and as the contact point of the relay closes, the power is supplied to the battery blower.
When a fan actuation signal is transmitted from the battery ECU, the blower motor controller adjusts
voltage (VM) which is applied to the battery blower in order to get the requested fan speed. The adjusted
voltage is also transmitted to the VM terminal of the battery ECU in the form of a monitoring signal. The
blower motor controller corrects the voltage at the blower motor by monitoring voltage at the +B terminal
of the battery blower.
Battery ECU
No. 1 Battery Blower
FCTL1
Battery Blower
VM
BATT FAN
+B
MAIN
Auxiliary Battery
VM
GND
SI
HB
SI
Duty Signal
Battery Blower Motor Controller
A133090E01
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A84
Battery blower voltage is lower than
malfunction threshold at constant vehicle
speed
•
•
•
•
•
•
P0A85
Battery blower voltage is higher than
malfunction threshold at constant vehicle
speed
•
•
•
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
BATT FAN fuse
No. 1 battery blower relay
Battery blower
Quarter vent duct (battery blower motor
controller)
Battery ECU
Wire harness or connector
BATT FAN fuse
No. 1 battery blower relay
Battery blower
Quarter vent duct (battery blower motor
controller)
Battery ECU
HB–46
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Battery ECU
No. 1 Battery Blower
FCTL1
Battery Blower
VM
BATT FAN
+B
Battery Blower
Motor Controller
VM
SI
SI
GND
From Auxiliary Battery
A133091E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FUSE (BATT FAN)
(a) Remove the BATT FAN fuse from the engine room relay
block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the BATT FAN fuse.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
(c) Reinstall the BATT FAN fuse.
Engine Room Relay Block
HB
BATT FAN Fuse
NG
C129041E01
OK
Go to step 14
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
2
INSPECT NO. 1 BATTERY BLOWER RELAY
1
5
(a) Remove the No. 1 battery blower relay.
(b) Measure the resistance of the terminals of the relay.
Standard resistance
2
3
5
1
HB–47
2
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(Apply battery voltage to terminals 1
and 2)
3
B060778E30
(c) Reinstall the No. 1 battery blower relay.
NG
REPLACE NO. 1 BATTERY BLOWER RELAY
OK
3
INSPECT BATTERY BLOWER
2 (+)
B9
(a) Disconnect the B9 battery blower connector.
(b) Connect the positive terminal of the battery to terminal 2
of the battery blower connector, and the negative battery
terminal to terminal 1 of the connector.
(c) Check that the blower fan rotates when voltage is
applied.
OK:
Blower fan rotates
1 (-)
A090450E03
NG
REPLACE BATTERY BLOWER
OK
4
HB
CHECK BATTERY BLOWER MOTOR CONTROLLER
(a) Check the battery blower motor controller (see page HB159).
NG
OK
REPLACE QUARTER VENT DUCT (BATTERY
BLOWER MOTOR CONTROLLER)
HB–48
5
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (NO. 1 BATTERY BLOWER RELAY - BATT FAN FUSE)
(a) Remove the B14 No. 1 battery blower relay.
(b) Remove the BATT FAN fuse from the engine room relay
block.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Relay Holder Side
No. 1 Battery Blower Relay
3
B14
5
1
2
Engine Room Relay Block
BATT FAN Fuse
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
B14-1 and 3 - BATT FAN fuse
terminal 2
Below 1 Ω
NOTICE:
When taking a measurement with a tester, do not
apply excessive force to the tester probe to avoid
damaging the holder.
(d) Reinstall the No. 1 battery blower relay.
(e) Reinstall the BATT FAN fuse.
NG
A131431E01
HB
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
6
HB–49
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (NO. 1 BATTERY BLOWER RELAY - BATTERY BLOWER)
(a) Remove the B14 No. 1 battery blower relay.
(b) Disconnect the B9 battery blower connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Relay Holder Side
No. 1 Battery Blower Relay
3
B14
5
1
2
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
B14-5 - B9-2
Below 1 Ω
NOTICE:
When taking a measurement with a tester, do not
apply excessive force to the tester probe to avoid
damaging the holder.
(d) Reinstall the No. 1 battery blower relay.
(e) Reconnect the battery blower connector.
Wire Harness Side
Battery Blower
NG
B9
1 2
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
A131597E01
OK
7
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (BATTERY BLOWER - BATTERY BLOWER MOTOR
CONTROLLER)
(a) Disconnect the B9 battery blower connector.
(b) Disconnect the B10 battery blower motor controller
connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Battery Blower
B9
1 2
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
B9-2 - B10-3 (+B)
Below 1 Ω
(d) Reconnect the battery blower connector.
(e) Reconnect the battery blower motor controller connector.
NG
B10
1
2
3
4
Battery
Blower
Motor
Controller
+B
A131598E01
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
HB
HB–50
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
OK
8
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (BATTERY BLOWER - BATTERY ECU)
(a) Disconnect the B9 battery blower connector.
(b) Disconnect the B11 battery ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Battery Blower
B9
1 2
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
B9-1 - B11-9 (VM)
Below 1 Ω
B9-1 or B11-9 (VM) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the battery blower connector.
(e) Reconnect the battery ECU connector.
NG
B11
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
Battery ECU
VM
A131599E01
OK
9
HB
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (BATTERY BLOWER - BATTERY BLOWER MOTOR
CONTROLLER)
(a) Disconnect the B9 battery blower connector.
(b) Disconnect the B10 battery blower motor controller
connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
B9
1 2
Battery Blower
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
B9-1 - B10-4 (VM)
Below 1 Ω
B9-1 or B10-4 (VM) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the battery blower connector.
(e) Reconnect the battery blower motor controller connector.
NG
B10
1
2
3
4
Battery
Blower
Motor
Controller
VM
A131598E02
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
HB–51
OK
10
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (NO. 1 BATTERY BLOWER RELAY - BATTERY ECU)
(a) Remove the B14 No. 1 battery blower relay.
(b) Disconnect the B11 battery ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Relay Holder Side
No. 1 Battery Blower Relay
3
5
B14
1
2
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
B14-2 - B11-10 (FCTL1)
Below 1 Ω
B14-2 or B11-10 (FCTL1) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
NOTICE:
When taking a measurement with a tester, do not
apply excessive force to the tester probe to avoid
damaging the holder.
(d) Reinstall the No. 1 battery blower relay.
(e) Reconnect the battery ECU connector.
B11
Battery ECU
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
FCTL1
A131600E01
OK
11
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (BATTERY BLOWER MOTOR CONTROLLER - BATTERY ECU)
Wire Harness Side
B10
1
2
3
4
Battery
Blower
Motor
Controller
SI
(a) Disconnect the B10 battery blower motor controller
connector.
(b) Disconnect the B11 battery ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
B10-2 (SI) - B11-24 (SI)
Below 1 Ω
B10-2 (SI) or B11-24 (SI) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the battery blower motor controller connector.
(e) Reconnect the battery ECU connector.
B11
NG
Battery ECU
SI
A131601E01
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
HB
HB–52
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
OK
12
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (BATTERY BLOWER MOTOR CONTROLLER - BODY GROUND)
Wire Harness Side
Battery
Blower
Motor
Controller
B10
GND
(a) Disconnect the B10 battery blower motor controller
connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
B10-1 (GND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
(c) Reconnect the battery blower motor controller connector.
A090454E13
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
13
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (NO. 1 BATTERY BLOWER RELAY)
(a) Remove the B14 No. 1 battery blower relay.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Relay Holder Side
3
B14
5
1
2
No. 1 Battery Blower Relay
A129366E01
HB
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
B14-1 - B14-3
Below 1 Ω
NOTICE:
When taking a measurement with a tester, do not
apply excessive force to the tester probe to avoid
damaging the holder.
(c) Reinstall the No. 1 battery blower relay.
NG
OK
REPLACE BATTERY ECU
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
14
HB–53
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (NO. 1 BATTERY BLOWER RELAY - BATT FAN FUSE)
(a) Remove the B14 No. 1 battery blower relay.
(b) Remove the BATT FAN fuse from the engine room relay
block.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Relay Holder Side
No. 1 Battery Blower Relay
3
B14
5
1
2
Engine Room Relay Block
BATT FAN Fuse
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
B14-3 or BATT FAN fuse terminal 2 Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NOTICE:
When taking a measurement with a tester, do not
apply excessive force to the tester probe to avoid
damaging the holder.
(d) Reinstall the No. 1 battery blower relay.
(e) Reinstall the BATT FAN fuse.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR AND REPLACE FUSE (BATT
FAN)
A131431E01
OK
HB
HB–54
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
15
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (NO. 1 BATTERY BLOWER RELAY - BATTERY BLOWER)
(a) Remove the B14 No. 1 battery blower relay.
(b) Disconnect the B9 battery blower connector.
(c) Disconnect the B10 battery blower motor controller
connector.
(d) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Relay Holder Side
No. 1 Battery Blower Relay
3
B14
5
1
2
Wire Harness Side
1 2
Battery Blower Motor Controller
B10
1
2
3
4
+B
A131602E01
HB
OK
Specified Condition
B14-5, B9-2 or B10-3 (+B) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
NOTICE:
When taking a measurement with a tester, do not
apply excessive force to the tester probe to avoid
damaging the holder.
(e) Reinstall the No. 1 battery blower relay.
(f) Reconnect the battery blower connector.
(g) Reconnect the battery blower motor controller connector.
Battery Blower
B9
Tester Connection
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR AND REPLACE FUSE (BATT
FAN)
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
16
HB–55
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (NO. 1 BATTERY BLOWER RELAY - BATTERY ECU)
(a) Remove the B14 No. 1 battery blower relay.
(b) Disconnect the B11 battery ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Relay Holder Side
No. 1 Battery Blower Relay
3
5
B14
1
2
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
B14-1, B14-3 or B11-10 (FCTL1) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NOTICE:
When taking a measurement with a tester, do not
apply excessive force to the tester probe to avoid
damaging the holder.
(d) Reinstall the No. 1 battery blower relay.
(e) Reconnect the battery ECU connector.
B11
NG
Battery ECU
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR AND REPLACE FUSE (BATT
FAN)
FCTL1
A131600E01
OK
17
CHECK BATTERY BLOWER MOTOR CONTROLLER
(a) Check the battery blower motor controller (see page HB159).
NG
OK
REPLACE BATTERY ECU
REPLACE QUARTER VENT DUCT (BATTERY
BLOWER MOTOR CONTROLLER)
HB
HB–56
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
DTC
P0A95
High Voltage Fuse
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A95
Voltage between VBB9 and VBB10 terminals
is below standard in spite of interlock switch
being engaged (1 trip detection logic)
•
•
•
•
High voltage fuse
Service plug grip
Battery plug
Battery ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
(+)
HV Battery Assembly
Battery ECU
Service Plug Grip
VBB10
High Voltage
VBB9
(-)
HB
C118375E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
READ DTC OUTPUT (DTC P0A1F IS OUTPUT)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and the tester ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV BATTERY / DTC INFO / TROUBLE CODES.
(d) Read DTCs.
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
HB–57
Result:
DTC P0A1F is output
YES
REPLACE BATTERY ECU
NO
2
INSPECT SERVICE PLUG GRIP
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-153).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the service
plug grip removed could cause a malfunction. Therefore,
never turn the power switch ON (READY) in this state.
(c) Measure the resistance of the service plug grip.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
A081749E01
NG
Go to step 4
OK
3
INSPECT BATTERY PLUG
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves and goggles before performing
the following operation.
(a) Remove the HV battery assembly (see page HB-88).
(b) Remove the battery plug (see page HB-112).
(c) Measure the resistance of the battery plug.
Standard resistance
A
B
D
C
A093184E01
OK
REPLACE BATTERY ECU
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A-C
Below 1 Ω
B-D
Below 1 Ω
(d) Reinstall the battery plug (see page HB-112).
(e) Reinstall the HV battery assembly (see page HB-88).
NG
REPLACE BATTERY PLUG
HB
HB–58
4
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
INSPECT HIGH VOLTAGE FUSE
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Remove the high voltage fuse (see page HB-153).
HINT:
The high voltage fuse is enclosed in the service plug
grip.
(b) Measure the resistance of the high voltage fuse.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
(c) Reinstall the high voltage fuse.
A057824E01
OK
REPLACE SERVICE PLUG GRIP
HB
NG
REPLACE HIGH VOLTAGE FUSE
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
HB–59
DTC
P0A9C
Hybrid Battery Temperature Sensor "A"
DTC
P0A9D
Hybrid Battery Temperature Sensor "A" Circuit
Low
DTC
P0A9E
Hybrid Battery Temperature Sensor "A" Circuit
High
DESCRIPTION
Reference:
Sensor Characteristic Diagram
Resistance kΩ
250
200
150
100
50
0
Battery Temperature °C (°F)
HB
C118369E01
3 battery temperature sensors are located on the bottom of the HV battery assembly. The resistance of
the thermistor, which is enclosed in each battery temperature sensor, changes in accordance with the
changes in the temperature of the HV battery assembly. The lower the battery temperature, the higher the
resistance of the thermistor. Conversely, the higher the temperature, the lower the resistance.
The battery ECU uses the battery temperature sensors to detect the temperature of the HV battery
assembly. Based on the results of this detection, the battery ECU controls the battery blower. (Thus, the
blower fan starts when the HV battery temperature rises to a predetermined level.)
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A9C
Battery temperature sensor malfunction
•
P0A9D
Low resistance in battery temperature sensor
•
•
•
P0A9E
High resistance in battery temperature sensor
•
•
HV battery assembly (HV battery
temperature sensor)
Battery ECU
HV battery assembly (HV battery
temperature sensor)
Battery ECU
HV battery assembly (HV battery
temperature sensor)
Battery ECU
HB–60
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
HINT:
After confirming DTC P0A9C, P0A9D and P0A9E, enter the following menus on the intelligent tester:
DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD / HV BATTERY / DATA LIST. Then, confirm the temperature of the HV battery
by checking "BATT TEMP 1 to 3".
Temperature Displayed
Malfunction
-45°C (-49°F) or less
Open or +B short circuit
95°C (203°F) or more
GND short circuit
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
If the temperature indicated by the battery temperature sensors is lower than the standard level (open), or
is higher than the standard level (short), the battery ECU interprets this as a sensor malfunction. If the
battery ECU detects that HV battery temperature is out of a normal range or its value is abnormal, it
illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Case 1: Battery temperature sensor malfunction
Related DTCs
P0A9C
Related Sensor/Components (Main)
Battery temperature sensor
Related Sensor/Components (Related)
None
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL Operation
Immediate
Sequence of Operation
None
Case 2: Battery temperature sensor low resistance
HB
Related DTCs
P0A9D
Related Sensor/Components (Main)
Battery temperature sensor
Related Sensor/Components (Related)
None
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL Operation
Immediate
Sequence of Operation
None
Case 3: Battery temperature high resistance
Related DTCs
P0A9E
Related Sensor/Components (Main)
Battery temperature sensor
Related Sensor/Components (Related)
None
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL Operation
Immediate
Sequence of Operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Case 1: Battery temperature sensor malfunction
Temperature deviation among batteries
(Maximum temperature - minimum temperature)
Exceeds standard level
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
HB–61
Case 2: Battery temperature sensor low resistance
Resistance of battery temperature sensor
1.108 kΩ or less
Case 3: Battery temperature high resistance
Resistance of battery temperature sensor
247.7 kΩ or more
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Battery temperature sensor
9 to 11 kΩ (at 25°C (77°F))
WIRING DIAGRAM
Battery ECU
5V
Battery Temperature Sensor 1
TB1
GB1
5V
Battery Temperature Sensor 2
TB2
GB2
5V
Battery Temperature Sensor 3
TB3
GB3
C118376E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
READ DTC OUTPUT (DTC P0A1F IS OUTPUT)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and the tester ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV BATTERY / DTC INFO / TROUBLE CODES.
(d) Read DTCs.
HB
HB–62
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
Result:
DTC P0A1F is output
YES
REPLACE BATTERY ECU
NO
2
CHECK CONNECTION OF BATTERY TEMPERATURE SENSOR CONNECTOR
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-153).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause a
malfunction. Therefore, never turn the power switch
ON (READY) in this state.
(c) Check the connection condition of the B13 battery ECU
connector.
OK:
Connector has been connected securely and there
is no poor connection.
HINT:
Since the battery temperature sensor is not available by
itself, if replacement is required, replace the entire HV
battery assembly.
B13
GB3 TB3 GB2 TB2 GB1 TB1
Battery ECU
A093174E01
NG
OK
HB
REPLACE HV SUPPLY BATTERY ASSEMBLY
CONNECT SECURELY
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
DTC
P0AAC
HB–63
Hybrid Battery Pack Air Temperature Sensor
"A" Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The intake air temperature sensor is provided on the HV battery assembly. Its resistance value varies with
the changes in the intake air temperature. The characteristics of the intake air temperature sensor are the
same as the battery temperature sensors (see page HB-55).
The battery ECU uses the signals from the intake air temperature sensor for adjusting the air flow speed
of the battery blower.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0AAC
Temperature detected by intake air
temperature sensor is lower than standard
(open) or higher than standard (short) (1 trip
detection logic)
•
•
HV battery assembly (intake air
temperature sensor)
Battery ECU
HINT:
After confirming DTC P0AAC, enter the following menus on the intelligent tester: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/
MOBD / HV BATTERY / DATA LIST. Then, confirm the temperature of the intake ambient air to the
battery pack by checking "BATT INSIDE AIR".
Temperature Displayed
Malfunction
-45°C (-49°F) or less
Open or +B short circuit
95°C (203°F) or more
GND short circuit
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
If the temperature indicated by the intake air temperature sensor is lower than the standard level (open),
or is higher than the standard level (short), the battery ECU determines that a malfunction has occurred. If
the battery ECU detects an abnormal intake air temperature, it will illuminate the MIL and set a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0AAC: Intake cooling air temperature sensor/Range check
Required sensors/components
Intake air temperature sensor
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Resistance of intake air temperature sensor
1.108 kΩ or less or 247.7 kΩ or more
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Intake air temperature sensor
9 to 11 kΩ (at 25°C (77°F))
HB
HB–64
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Battery ECU
Battery Intake Air Temperature Sensor
5V
TC1
GC1
C118378E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
HB
READ DTC OUTPUT (DTC P0A1F IS OUTPUT)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and the tester ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV BATTERY / DTC INFO / TROUBLE CODES.
(d) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTC P0A1F is output
YES
REPLACE BATTERY ECU
NO
2
CHECK CONNECTION OF INTAKE AIR TEMPERATURE SENSOR CONNECTOR
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-153).
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause a
malfunction. Therefore, never turn the power switch
ON (READY) in this state.
(c) Check the connection condition of the B13 battery ECU
connector.
OK:
Connector has been connected securely and there
is no poor connection.
HINT:
Since the intake air temperature sensor is not available it
self, if replacement is required, replace the entire HV
battery assembly.
B13
GC1
TC1
Battery ECU
HB–65
A093174E05
NG
CONNECT SECURELY
OK
REPLACE HV SUPPLY BATTERY ASSEMBLY
HB
HB–66
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
DTC
P0ABF
Hybrid Battery Pack Current Sensor Circuit
DTC
P0AC0
Hybrid Battery Pack Current Sensor Circuit
Range/Performance
DTC
P0AC1
Hybrid Battery Pack Current Sensor Circuit
Low
DTC
P0AC2
Hybrid Battery Pack Current Sensor Circuit
High
DESCRIPTION
The battery current sensor, which is mounted on the negative cable side of the HV battery assembly,
detects the amperage that flows into the HV battery. The battery current sensor inputs a voltage (which
varies between 0 to 5 V in proportion to the amperage) into the IB terminal of the battery ECU. An output
voltage of the battery current sensor below 2.5 V indicates that the HV battery assembly is being charged,
and above 2.5 V indicates that the HV battery assembly is being discharged.
The battery ECU determines the charging and discharging amperage of the HV battery assembly based
on the signals that are input to its IB terminal, and calculates the SOC (state of charge) of the HV battery
through the estimation of the amperage.
Battery Current Sensor
Output Voltage (V)
Battery ECU
4.5
HB
VIB
IB
GIB
HV
Battery
2.5
0.5
Discharging
Amperage
-200
Charging
Amperage
0
Charging
200
Discharging
HV Battery Amperage (A)
Battery Current Sensor
A093186E01
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0ABF
Power source of battery current sensor
•
•
•
P0AC0
Battery current sensor malfunction
•
•
•
HV battery assembly (wire harness or
connector)
Battery current sensor
Battery ECU
HV battery assembly (wire harness or
connector)
Battery current sensor
Battery ECU
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0AC1
Low voltage in battery current sensor
•
•
•
P0AC2
High voltage in battery current sensor
•
•
•
HB–67
HV battery assembly (wire harness or
connector)
Battery current sensor
Battery ECU
HV battery assembly (wire harness or
connector)
Battery current sensor
Battery ECU
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
If the battery ECU detects malfunction in the battery current sensor, it will illuminate the MIL and set a
DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Case 1: Power source of battery current sensor
Related DTCs
P0ABF
Related Sensor/Components (Main)
Battery temperature sensor
Related Sensor/Components (Related)
None
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL Operation
Immediate
Sequence of Operation
None
Case 2: Battery current sensor malfunction
Related DTCs
P0AC0
Related Sensor/Components (Main)
Battery temperature sensor
Related Sensor/Components (Related)
None
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL Operation
2 driving cycles
Sequence of Operation
None
Case 3: Battery current sensor low voltage
Related DTCs
P0AC1
Related Sensor/Components (Main)
Battery temperature sensor
Related Sensor/Components (Related)
None
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL Operation
Immediate
Sequence of Operation
None
Case 4: Battery current sensor high voltage
Related DTCs
P0AC2
Related Sensor/Components (Main)
Battery temperature sensor
Related Sensor/Components (Related)
None
Frequency of Operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL Operation
Immediate
Sequence of Operation
None
HB
HB–68
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Case 1: Power source of battery current sensor
Power-supply voltage for current sensor
Exceeds standard level
Case 2: Battery current sensor malfunction
Sensor current
Exceeds standard level
Case 3: Battery current sensor low voltage
Sensor voltage
Exceeds standard level
Case 4: Battery current sensor high voltage
Sensor voltage
Exceeds standard level
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Battery current sensor
DTC P0ABF, P0AC0, P0AC1 and P0AC2 are not detected
WIRING DIAGRAM
Battery Current Sensor
IB
Battery ECU
IB
HB
VIB
VIB
GIB
GIB
C118377E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
HB–69
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
READ DTC OUTPUT (DTC P0A1F IS OUTPUT)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and the tester ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV BATTERY / DTC INFO / TROUBLE CODES.
(d) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTC P0A1F is output
YES
REPLACE BATTERY ECU
NO
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (BATTERY ECU - BATTERY CURRENT SENSOR)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-153).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause a
malfunction. Therefore, never turn the power switch
ON (READY) in this state.
(c) Disconnect the B13 battery ECU connector.
(d) Disconnect the battery current sensor connector.
(e) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with the service plug
grip removed.
(f) Measure the voltage of the battery ECU connector.
Standard voltage
B13
Battery ECU
IB
Tester Connection
GIB
VIB
Wire Harness Side
1
VIB
2
GIB
Battery
Current
Sensor
3
IB
A131603E01
Specified Condition
B13-16 (IB) - Body ground
Below 1 V
B13-14 (GIB) - Body ground
Below 1 V
B13-15 (VIB) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(g) Turn the power switch OFF.
(h) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
B13-16 (IB) - 3 (battery current
sensor)
Below 1 Ω
B13-14 (GIB) - 2 (battery current
sensor)
Below 1 Ω
B13-15 (VIB) - 1 (battery current
sensor)
Below 1 Ω
HB
HB–70
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
B13-16 (IB) or 3 (battery current
sensor) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
B13-14 (GIB) or 2 (battery current
sensor) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
B13-15 (VIB) or 1 (battery current
sensor) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(i) Reconnect the battery current sensor connector.
(j) Reconnect the battery ECU connector.
(k) Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-153).
HINT:
Since the wire harness is not available by itself, if
replacement is required, replace the entire HV battery
assembly.
NG
REPAIR HARNESS AND CONNECTOR, OR
REPLACE HV SUPPLY BATTERY ASSEMBLY
OK
3
REPLACE BATTERY CURRENT SENSOR
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
HB
Replace the battery current sensor (see page HB-141).
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG) and the tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV BATTERY / DTC INFO / TROUBLE CODES.
(e) Perform a simulation test.
HINT:
Some of the steps involve the detection of 2 trips.
Therefore, after performing a simulation test, turn the
power switch OFF, and perform the simulation test again.
NEXT
4
READ DTC OUTPUT (DTC P0ABF, P0AC0, P0AC1 AND P0AC2 IS NOT OUTPUT)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and the tester ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV BATTERY / DTC INFO / TROUBLE CODES.
(d) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTC P0ABF, P0AC0, P0AC1 and P0AC2 is not
output again
NO
YES
SYSTEM IS OK
REPLACE BATTERY ECU
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
DTC
P0AFA
HB–71
Hybrid Battery System Voltage Low
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0A80 (see page HB-35).
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0AFA
Either of the following conditions occurs (1 trip
detection logic)
• Voltage at each battery block is below 2 V
• Voltage of all the battery blocks is -24 to 2
V
•
•
•
Junction block assembly (busbar module)
No. 2 frame wire (busbar and wire
harness)
Battery ECU
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The battery ECU monitors a voltage of the battery blocks to detect an open malfunction in internal battery
voltage sensor circuits of the battery ECU and the wire harness between each battery block and battery
ECU. If a voltage at one of the battery blocks is below a standard level or of all the battery blocks is within
a specified range, the battery ECU judges that there is an open in the internal sensor circuit(s) or wire
harness. The battery ECU then illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0AFA: Battery voltage sensor/Range check
Required sensors/components
The wire harness from each battery block to the battery ECU
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Either of the following conditions is satisfied:
(a) or (b)
(a) Voltage at single battery block
Below 2 V
(b) Voltage of all battery blocks
-24 to 2 V
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Battery ECU
No open malfunction
HB
HB–72
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Battery ECU
VBB14
VBB13
VBB12
VBB11
VBB10
VBB9
HV Battery
VBB8
Busbar
Module
VBB7
VBB6
VBB5
VBB4
VBB3
VBB2
VBB1
GBB0
HB
C118379E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
READ DTC OUTPUT (DTC P0A1F IS OUTPUT)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and the tester ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV BATTERY / DTC INFO / TROUBLE CODES.
(d) Read DTCs.
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
HB–73
Result:
DTC P0A1F is output
YES
REPLACE BATTERY ECU
NO
2
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (BATTERY BLOCK VOL-V01 TO V14)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and the tester ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV BATTERY / DATA LIST.
(d) Read "V1 to V14 BATTERY BLOCK" on the tester.
Standard voltage:
2 V or more
OK
Go to step 5
NG
3
CHECK JUNCTION BLOCK ASSEMBLY (BUSBAR MODULE)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves and goggles before performing
the following operation.
(a) Remove the battery assembly (see page HB-88).
(b) Remove the battery cover (see page HB-88).
(c) Check that the nuts of the junction block are tightened to
the specified torque.
Torque: 5.4 N*m (55 kgf*cm, 48 in.*lbf)
NG
TIGHTEN NUTS TO SPECIFIED TORQUE
A081782E01
OK
4
CHECK NO. 2 FRAME WIRE (BUSBAR MODULE)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves and goggles before performing
the following operation.
HB
HB–74
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
(a) Check that the nuts of the No. 2 frame wire are tightened
to the specified torque.
Torque: 5.4 N*m (55 kgf*cm, 48 in.*lbf)
NG
TIGHTEN NUTS TO SPECIFIED TORQUE
A081783E01
OK
5
CHECK CONNECTION OF NO. 2 FRAME WIRE CONNECTOR
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Check the connection condition of the B12 battery ECU
connector.
OK:
Connector has been connected securely and there
is no poor connection.
B12
NG
CONNECT SECURELY
Battery ECU
A093174E02
OK
HB
6
INSPECT NO. 2 FRAME WIRE (BUSBAR MODULE)
#1 #3
#2
#5
#4
#7
#9
#6
#11 #13
#14
#15
#8 #10 #12
B12
Battery
ECU
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves and goggles before performing
the following operation.
(a) Remove the No. 2 frame wire (see page HB-108).
(b) Measure the resistance of each connector and the metal
portions of the No. 2 frame wire.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
B12-22 (GBB0) - #1
Below 1 Ω
B12-11 (VBB1) - #2
Below 1 Ω
B12-21 (VBB2) - #3
Below 1 Ω
B12-10 (VBB3) - #4
Below 1 Ω
B12-20 (VBB4) - #5
Below 1 Ω
B12-9 (VBB5) - #6
Below 1 Ω
B12-19 (VBB6) - #7
Below 1 Ω
B12-8 (VBB7) - #8
Below 1 Ω
B12-18 (VBB8) - #9
Below 1 Ω
B12-7 (VBB9) - #10
Below 1 Ω
B12-17 (VBB10) - #11
Below 1 Ω
A090457E01
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
B12-6 (VBB11) - #12
Below 1 Ω
B12-16 (VBB12) - #13
Below 1 Ω
B12-5 (VBB13) - #14
Below 1 Ω
B12-15 (VBB14) - #15
Below 1 Ω
HB–75
(c) Reinstall the No. 2 frame wire.
NG
REPLACE NO. 2 FRAME WIRE
OK
REPLACE BATTERY ECU
HB
HB–76
HB
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
DTC
P3011
Battery Block 1 Becomes Weak
DTC
P3012
Battery Block 2 Becomes Weak
DTC
P3013
Battery Block 3 Becomes Weak
DTC
P3014
Battery Block 4 Becomes Weak
DTC
P3015
Battery Block 5 Becomes Weak
DTC
P3016
Battery Block 6 Becomes Weak
DTC
P3017
Battery Block 7 Becomes Weak
DTC
P3018
Battery Block 8 Becomes Weak
DTC
P3019
Battery Block 9 Becomes Weak
DTC
P3020
Battery Block 10 Becomes Weak
DTC
P3021
Battery Block 11 Becomes Weak
DTC
P3022
Battery Block 12 Becomes Weak
DTC
P3023
Battery Block 13 Becomes Weak
DTC
P3024
Battery Block 14 Becomes Weak
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0A80 (see page HB-35).
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P3011
P3012
P3013
P3014
P3015
P3016
P3017
P3018
P3019
P3020
P3021
P3022
P3023
P3024
Presence of a malfunctioning block is
determined based on the voltages from the
battery blocks (1 trip detection logic)
•
•
HV battery assembly
Battery ECU
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
HB–77
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
If there is an abnormal internal resistance or electromotive voltage in the battery blocks, the battery ECU
determines that a malfunction has occurred. When the malfunction detection condition is satisfied, the
battery ECU illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P3011 to P3024: HV battery/Rationality
Required sensors/components
HV battery
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
HV battery
Abnormal
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
HV battery
DTCs P3011 to P3024 are not detected
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0AFA (see page HB-68).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
HB
READ DTC OUTPUT (DTC P0A1F IS OUTPUT)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and the tester ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV BATTERY / DTC INFO / TROUBLE CODES.
(d) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTC P0A1F is output
YES
REPLACE BATTERY ECU
NO
2
CHECK BATTERY BLOCK VOLTAGE
(a) Depress the brake pedal and turn the power switch ON
(IG).
(b) Depress the brake pedal and accelerator pedal to charge
with the HV battery.
HB–78
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
(c) Read the battery block voltage in the DATA LIST. Enter
the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD / HV
BATTERY / DATA LIST. Read the values of "V1 BATT
BLOCK" to "V14 BATT BLOCK".
(d) Compare the voltages as listed below.
• V1 BATT BLOCK and V2 BATT BLOCK
• V3 BATT BLOCK and V4 BATT BLOCK
• V5 BATT BLOCK and V6 BATT BLOCK
• V7 BATT BLOCK and V8 BATT BLOCK
• V9 BATT BLOCK and V10 BATT BLOCK
• V11 BATT BLOCK and V12 BATT BLOCK
• V13 BATT BLOCK and V14 BATT BLOCK
Result:
All of the battery voltage differences are 0.3 V or more.
YES
NO
REPLACE HV SUPPLY BATTERY ASSEMBLY
HB
REPLACE BATTERY ECU
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
DTC
U0100
Lost Communication with ECM/PCM "A"
DTC
U0293
Lost Communication with HV ECU
HB–79
DESCRIPTION
The battery ECU receives signals from the hybrid vehicle control ECU, ECM, and gateway ECU via CAN
(Controller Area Network) communication.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
U0100
CAN communication malfunction (no signal
reception) with ECM
CAN communication system
U0293
CAN communication malfunction (no signal
reception) with hybrid vehicle control ECU
CAN communication system
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
If the battery ECU detects malfunction in the CAN communication with the ECM or hybrid vehicle control
ECU, it illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
U0100:
Related DTCs
U0100: Communication between ECM and battery ECU/Non-received
check
Required sensors/components
Main: ECM
Sub: CAN bus line
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
0.68 seconds or more
MIL operation
Immediate or 1 driving cycle
Sequence of operation
None
U0293:
Related DTCs
U0293: Communication between hybrid vehicle control and battery
ECU/Non-received check
Required sensors/components
Main: Hybrid vehicle control ECU
Sub: CAN bus line
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
0.68 seconds or more
MIL operation
Immediate
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Receiving data
No reception
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
ECM
DTC U0100 is not detected
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
DTC U0293 is not detected
HB
HB–80
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HYBRID BATTERY SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ DTC OUTPUT (CODES ALL)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and the tester ON.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
CODES (ALL).
(d) Read and record DTCs.
HINT:
When DTCs other than CAN communication malfunction
DTCs are output simultaneously, first correct the CAN
communication problem, and then perform
troubleshooting for other DTCs.
NEXT
GO TO CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
HB
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HV BATTERY
HB–77
HV BATTERY
PRECAUTION
CAUTION:
The hybrid system uses high voltage circuits, so
improper handling could cause an electric shock or
leakage. During service (e.g. installing or removing the
parts, inspection, replacing the parts), be sure to follow
the procedures below.
1. DISCONNECT POWER SOURCE WHEN
PERFORMING WORK ON HIGH VOLTAGE SYSTEM
(a) Ensure that the power switch is OFF.
(b) Disconnect the negative terminal cable from the
auxiliary battery (see page HB-153).
(c) Always wear insulating gloves (see item 2 below).
NOTICE:
DTCs will also be erased, so if necessary check
DTCs before disconnecting the power source
OFF.
(d) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-153).
NOTICE:
• After removing the service plug grip, do not
operate the power switch as it may damage
the hybrid vehicle control ECU.
• Keep the removed service plug grip in your
pocket to prevent other technicians from
reconnecting it while you are servicing the
vehicle.
(e) Leave the vehicle for 5 minutes.
HINT:
It takes 5 minutes for the high voltage condenser in
the inverter to discharge its electricity.
2.
3.
D020384E01
4.
PRECAUTIONS FOR INSULATING GLOVES
(a) Before wearing, ensure that the insulating gloves
are not damaged with tears, holes or cracks.
(b) Do not wear wet gloves.
PRECAUTIONS FOR WIRE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
(a) The wire harnesses and connectors with high
voltage circuits are colored orange. In addition, high
voltage parts such as the HV battery are affixed with
a "High Voltage" caution label. Be careful not to
touch these wires.
PRECAUTIONS WHEN PERFORMING SERVICE OR
INSPECTIONS
(a) Always disconnect the power source before starting
work (see item 1 above).
(b) Always wear insulating gloves when inspecting or
servicing any high voltage wires and parts.
(c) Alert other technicians that you are working on the
high voltage systems with a warning sign such as
"High Voltage Work: Do Not Touch".
HB
HB–78
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HV BATTERY
(d) Do not carry any metal objects such as a
mechanical pencil or a measuring tape that could
fall and cause a short circuit.
(e) After removing any high voltage wires, insulate them
immediately with insulation tape.
(f) Always tighten the high voltage screw terminals to
the specified torque. Insufficient or excessive torque
will cause malfunctions.
(g) After finishing work on the high voltage systems and
before reinstalling the service plug, reconfirm that
you have not left any parts or tools lying around, that
the high voltage terminals are tightened and that the
connectors are connected.
HB
HB–79
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HV BATTERY
COMPONENTS
REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD
REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD
REAR DECK FLOOR BOX
6.0 (61, 53 in.*lbf)
NEGATIVE BATTERY
CABLE
SERVICE PLUG GRIP
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A124443E05
HB
HB–80
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HV BATTERY
TONNEAU COVER
REAR DECK TRIM COVER
LUGGAGE HOLD BELT STRIKER
LUGGAGE HOLD BELT
STRIKER
HB
REAR NO. 1 FLOOR BOARD
REAR SEAT CUSHION
ASSEMBLY
A124453E02
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HV BATTERY
HB–81
DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL RH
LUGGAGE HOLD BELT STRIKER
REAR NO. 4 FLOOR BOARD
REAR SIDE SEAT BACK FRAME RH
DECK FLOOR BOX LH
HB
DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL LH
REAR SIDE SEAT BACK FRAME LH
LUGGAGE HOLD BELT STRIKER
A124454E01
HB–82
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HV BATTERY
NO. 2 QUARTER VENT
DUCT INNER
NO. 1 BATTERY BLOWER RELAY
28 (286, 21)
BATTERY BRACKET REINFORCEMENT
28 (286, 21)
28 (286, 21)
28 (286, 21)
CONNECTOR
4.0 (41, 35 in.*lbf)
BATTERY CARRIER
BRACKET
HB
28 (286, 21)
QUARTER VENT DUCT
28 (286, 21)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A124455E01
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HV BATTERY
HB–83
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
NO. 6 BATTERY CARRIER PANEL
JUNCTION TERMINAL
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
19 (194, 14)
HV BATTERY ASSEMBLY
19 (194, 14)
WIRE HARNESS
19 (194, 14)
5.6 (57, 50 in.*lbf)
FRAME WIRE
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A124456E01
HB
HB–84
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HV BATTERY
NO. 1 BATTERY CARRIER
CATCH BRACKET
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
BATTERY COVER
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
PROTECTOR
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
MAIN BATTERY CABLE
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
TERMINAL COVER
NO. 1 WIRE
HARNESS
PROTECTOR
COVER
TERMINAL COVER
5.6 (57, 50 in.*lbf)
5.6 (57, 50 in.*lbf)
HB
5.4 (55, 48 in.*lbf)
NO. 3 WIRE HARNESS
PROTECTOR COVER
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
NO. 2 MAIN BATTERY CABLE
5.4 (55, 48 in.*lbf)
NO. 3 BATTERY CARRIER CUSHION
Non-reusable part
A124457E01
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HV BATTERY
HB–85
BATTERY CLAMP PAD
NO. 4 WIRE HARNESS PROTECTOR COVER
NO. 2 WIRE HARNESS PROTECTOR COVER
NO. 1 WIRE HARNESS PROTECTOR COVER
5.4 (55, 48 in.*lbf)
JUNCTION BLOCK
5.4 (55, 48 in.*lbf)
5.4 (55, 48 in.*lbf)
JUNCTION BLOCK
5.4 (55, 48 in.*lbf)
1.4 (14, 12 in.*lbf)
BATTERY CURRENT SENSOR
SERVICE PLUG
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A124458E01
HB
HB–86
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HV BATTERY
3.4 (35, 30 in.*lbf)
SYSTEM MAIN RESISTOR
3.4 (35, 30 in.*lbf)
SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
NO. 2 SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
3.4 (35, 30 in.*lbf)
3.4 (35, 30 in.*lbf)
NO. 3 SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
BATTERY ECU
3.3 (34, 29 in.*lbf)
3.4 (35, 30 in.*lbf)
HB
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
UPPER BATTERY
CARRIER
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A124459E01
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HV BATTERY
HB–87
BATTERY ROOM VENTILATION HOSE
NO. 2 BATTERY SPACER
HB
x 26
5.4 (55, 48 in.*lbf)
NO. 2 FRAME WIRE
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A124460E01
HB–88
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HV BATTERY
REMOVAL
CAUTION:
• When working on the high voltage systems, always
wear insulating gloves.
• Keep the removed service plug in your pocket to
prevent other technicians from reconnecting it while
you are servicing the vehicle.
• After removing the service plug grip, do not touch the
high voltage connectors and terminals for 5 minutes.
NOTICE:
After removing the service plug grip, do not operate the
power switch as it may damage the hybrid vehicle
control ECU.
1.
PRECAUTION
CAUTION:
The hybrid system uses high voltage circuits, so
improper handling could cause an electric shock or
leakage. During service (including installation/
removal, inspection and replacement of parts), be
sure to follow the procedures (see page HB-77).
2.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
3.
REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-4)
4.
REMOVE REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
5.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
6.
REMOVE SERVICE PLUG GRIP (See page HB-154)
7.
REMOVE REAR DECK TRIM COVER
(a) Detach the 4 clips shown in the illustration, then
remove the deck trim cover.
HB
Clip
A083536E03
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HV BATTERY
HB–89
8.
REMOVE TONNEAU COVER
(a) Remove the tonneau cover from the vehicle.
9.
REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY
(a) Undo the 2 joints shown in the illustration, then
remove the rear seat cushion.
A083594E01
: Joint
A083593E03
10. REMOVE REAR NO. 1 FLOOR BOARD
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and luggage hold belt strikers.
(b) Remove the 5 clips shown in the illustration and the
rear floor board.
: Clip
A083543E03
11. REMOVE REAR SIDE SEAT BACK FRAME LH
(a) Remove the bolt from the rear side seat back frame
LH.
(b) Undo the 3 joints, then remove the rear side seat
back frame LH.
: Joint
A083540E04
12. REMOVE REAR SIDE SEAT BACK FRAME RH
(a) Remove the bolt from the rear side seat back frame
RH.
(b) Undo the 4 joints, then remove the rear side seat
back frame RH.
: Joint
A083539E03
HB
HB–90
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HV BATTERY
13. REMOVE REAR NO. 4 FLOOR BOARD
(a) While lifting up the rear floor board as shown in the
illustration, undo the 2 joints and remove the rear
floor board.
: Joint
A083542E03
14. REMOVE DECK FLOOR BOX LH
(a) Remove the clip and deck floor box LH.
15. REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL LH
(a) Remove the bolt and luggage hold belt striker.
Clip
A083541E01
(b) Remove the 2 bolts from the deck trim side panel
LH.
(c) Remove the clip from the deck trim side panel LH.
(d) Undo the 8 clips, then pull out a part of the weather
strip and remove the deck trim side panel LH.
(e) Disconnect the lighting connector.
16. REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL RH
(a) Remove the bolt and luggage hold belt striker.
HB
Clip
A083537E03
(b) Remove the 2 bolts from the deck trim side panel
RH.
(c) Remove the clip from the deck trim side panel RH.
(d) Undo the 7 clips, then pull out a part of the weather
strip and remove the deck trim side panel RH.
: Clip
A083538E05
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HV BATTERY
HB–91
17. REMOVE BATTERY CARRIER BRACKET
(a) Remove the 7 bolts and battery carrier bracket.
A083527E01
No. 1 Battery Blower Relay
18. REMOVE NO. 2 QUARTER VENT DUCT INNER
(a) Disconnect the clamp and No. 1 battery blower
relay.
(b) Remove the 2 clips.
(c) Slide the vent duct to the battery side, then remove
it.
A083530E02
19. REMOVE BATTERY BRACKET REINFORCEMENT
(a) Remove the 7 bolts and battery bracket
reinforcement.
A083528E01
20. REMOVE QUARTER VENT DUCT
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the clamp, then disconnect the wire
harness.
(c) Remove the bolt, clip and quarter vent duct.
Bolt
: Clamp
Clip
A083604E03
21. REMOVE NO. 6 BATTERY CARRIER PANEL
(a) Remove the 3 bolts, 2 nuts and battery carrier
panel.
A083532E01
HB
HB–92
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HV BATTERY
22. REMOVE JUNCTION TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
A083531E01
23. REMOVE FRAME WIRE
CAUTION:
• Wear insulating gloves.
• Insulate the removed terminals with insulating
tape.
(a) Remove the 2 nuts, then disconnect the frame wire
from the No. 2 and No. 3 system main relay.
A083533E03
24. REMOVE HV BATTERY ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the earth bolt and 4 bolts shown in the
illustration.
Earth Bolt
A083534E02
HB
System Main
Relay Connector
Battery ECU
Connector
Interlock
Connector
: Clamp
A083535E06
(b) Disconnect the system main relay connector.
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(c) Disconnect the interlock connector.
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(d) Remove the clamp, then disconnect the battery
ECU connector.
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(e) Disconnect the battery room ventilation hose from
the floor panel.
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(f) Remove the HV battery.
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
A083548E01
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HV BATTERY
HB–93
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE BATTERY COVER
(a) Remove the protector shown in the illustration.
(b) Remove the 6 bolts, 2 nuts, clip, battery cover and
battery carrier catch bracket.
A083610E01
Clip
Battery Cover
No. 1 Battery Carrier
Catch Bracket
A083611E01
2.
REMOVE NO. 1 WIRE HARNESS PROTECTOR
COVER (See page HB-102)
3.
REMOVE NO. 3 WIRE HARNESS PROTECTOR
COVER (See page HB-102)
4.
REMOVE NO. 3 BATTERY CARRIER CUSHION (See
page HB-103)
5.
REMOVE MAIN BATTERY CABLE (See page HB-103)
6.
REMOVE NO. 2 MAIN BATTERY CABLE (See page
HB-103)
7.
REMOVE BATTERY CURRENT SENSOR (See page
HB-142)
8.
REMOVE NO. 2 WIRE HARNESS PROTECTOR
COVER (See page HB-116)
9.
REMOVE NO. 4 WIRE HARNESS PROTECTOR
COVER (See page HB-116)
10. REMOVE BATTERY CLAMP PAD (See page HB-112)
11. REMOVE NO. 1 WIRE HARNESS PROTECTOR
COVER (See page HB-113)
12. REMOVE BATTERY PLUG (See page HB-113)
13. REMOVE JUNCTION BLOCK (See page HB-117)
14. REMOVE NO. 2 SYSTEM MAIN RELAY (See page HB123)
15. REMOVE NO. 3 SYSTEM MAIN RELAY (See page HB124)
16. REMOVE SYSTEM MAIN RESISTOR (See page HB136)
HB
HB–94
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HV BATTERY
17. REMOVE NO. 1 SYSTEM MAIN RELAY (See page HB124)
18. REMOVE BATTERY ECU (See page HB-149)
19. REMOVE UPPER BATTERY CARRIER
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(a) Remove the 3 nuts and upper battery carrier.
20. REMOVE NO. 2 BATTERY SPACER
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
21. REMOVE NO. 2 FRAME WIRE (See page HB-109)
A077549E01
22. REMOVE BATTERY ROOM VENTILATION HOSE
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
A077535E01
REASSEMBLY
HB
1.
INSTALL BATTERY ROOM VENTILATION HOSE
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves and protective glasses.
2.
INSTALL NO. 2 FRAME WIRE (See page HB-109)
3.
INSTALL NO. 2 BATTERY SPACER
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves and protective glasses.
4.
INSTALL UPPER BATTERY CARRIER
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves and protective glasses.
(a) Install the upper battery carrier with the 3 nuts.
Torque: 5.5 N*m (56 kgf*cm, 49 in.*lbf)
5.
INSTALL BATTERY ECU (See page HB-149)
6.
INSTALL NO. 1 SYSTEM MAIN RELAY (See page HB127)
7.
INSTALL SYSTEM MAIN RESISTOR (See page HB136)
8.
INSTALL NO. 3 SYSTEM MAIN RELAY (See page HB127)
9.
INSTALL NO. 2 SYSTEM MAIN RELAY (See page HB127)
A077535E01
A077549E01
10. INSPECT CONTACT CONDITION (See page HB-128)
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HV BATTERY
HB–95
11. INSTALL JUNCTION BLOCK (See page HB-117)
12. INSTALL BATTERY PLUG (See page HB-114)
13. INSTALL NO. 1 WIRE HARNESS PROTECTOR
COVER (See page HB-114)
14. INSTALL BATTERY CLAMP PAD (See page HB-114)
15. INSTALL NO. 4 WIRE HARNESS PROTECTOR
COVER
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
16. INSTALL NO. 2 WIRE HARNESS PROTECTOR
COVER
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
17. INSTALL BATTERY CURRENT SENSOR (See page
HB-143)
18. INSTALL NO. 2 MAIN BATTERY CABLE (See page
HB-104)
19. INSTALL MAIN BATTERY CABLE (See page HB-104)
20. INSTALL NO. 3 BATTERY CARRIER CUSHION (See
page HB-105)
21. INSTALL NO. 3 WIRE HARNESS PROTECTOR
COVER
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
22. INSTALL NO. 1 WIRE HARNESS PROTECTOR
COVER
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
HB
23. INSTALL BATTERY COVER
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(a) Temporarily fasten the battery carrier catch bracket
to the battery room ventilation hose.
(b) Install the battery cover with the 6 bolts, 2 nuts and
clip.
Battery Cover
Clip
No. 1 Battery Carrier
Catch Bracket
A083611E01
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
(c) Install the protector on the battery cover.
HB–96
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HV BATTERY
INSTALLATION
Earth Bolt
1.
INSTALL HV BATTERY ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the HV battery with the earth bolt and 4 bolts.
Torque: 19 N*m (194 kgf*cm, 14 in.*lbf)
A083534E02
System Main
Relay Connector
(b) Connect the system main relay connector.
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(c) Connect the interlock connector.
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(d) Connect the battery ECU connector.
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
Battery ECU
Connector
Interlock
Connector
: Clamp
A083535E06
(e) Connect the battery room ventilation hose to the
floor panel.
A083548E01
HB
2.
INSTALL FRAME WIRE
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(a) Install the frame wire on the No. 2 and No. 3 system
main relay with 2 new nuts.
Torque: 5.6 N*m (57 kgf*cm, 50 in.*lbf)
(b) Connect the 2 clamps, then install the frame wire to
the upper battery carrier.
3.
INSTALL JUNCTION TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
A083533E03
A083531E01
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HV BATTERY
HB–97
4.
INSTALL NO. 6 BATTERY CARRIER PANEL
(a) Install the battery carrier panel with the bolt and 2
nuts.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (76 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
5.
INSTALL QUARTER VENT DUCT
NOTICE:
Ensure that the duct is installed securely.
(a) Install the quarter vent duct with the bolt and clip.
Torque: 4.0 N*m (41 kgf*cm, 35 in.*lbf)
(b) Connect the connector.
(c) Install the clamp.
6.
INSTALL BATTERY BRACKET REINFORCEMENT
(a) Install the battery bracket reinforcement with the 7
bolts.
Torque: 28 N*m (286 kgf*cm, 21 in.*lbf)
7.
INSTALL NO. 2 QUARTER VENT DUCT INNER
(a) Insert the quarter vent duct inner until it touches the
backside of the HV battery.
(b) Slide the fitting surface of the quarter vent duct inner
downward, then attach it to the battery blower
assembly.
NOTICE:
Ensure that the duct is installed securely.
(c) Install the 2 clips on the vent duct.
(d) Install the battery blower relay.
8.
INSTALL BATTERY CARRIER BRACKET
(a) Install the battery carrier bracket with the 7 bolts.
Torque: 28 N*m (286 kgf*cm, 21 in.*lbf)
A083532E01
Bolt
: Clamp
Clip
A083604E04
A083528E01
No. 1 Battery Blower Relay
A083530E02
A083527E01
HB
HB–98
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HV BATTERY
9.
INSTALL DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL RH
(a) Install the deck trim side panel with the 7 clips and 2
bolts, and then install the part of the weather strip.
(b) Install the luggage hold belt striker with the bolt.
10. INSTALL DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL LH
(a) Connect the lighting connector.
: Clip
A083538E05
(b) Install the deck trim side panel with the 8 clips and 2
bolts, and then install the part of the weather strip.
(c) Install the luggage hold belt striker with the bolt.
Clip
A083537E03
HB
11. INSTALL DECK FLOOR BOX LH
(a) Install the deck floor box with the clip.
Clip
A083541E01
12. INSTALL REAR NO. 4 FLOOR BOARD
: Joint
A083542E04
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HV BATTERY
HB–99
13. INSTALL REAR SIDE SEAT BACK FRAME RH
(a) Install the seat back frame with the bolt.
: Joint
A083539E03
14. INSTALL REAR SIDE SEAT BACK FRAME LH
(a) Install the seat back frame with the bolt.
: Joint
A083540E04
15. INSTALL REAR NO. 1 FLOOR BOARD
(a) Install the floor board.
(b) Install the 2 luggage strikers with the 2 bolts.
: Clip
A083543E03
16. INSTALL REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY
: Joint
A083593E03
17. INSTALL TONNEAU COVER
A083594E01
HB
HB–100
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – HV BATTERY
18. INSTALL REAR DECK TRIM COVER
19. INSTALL SERVICE PLUG GRIP (See page HB-154)
20. CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL (See page CH-7)
21. INSTALL REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
Clip
A083536E03
22. INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-8)
23. INSTALL REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
24. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
HB
HB–101
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – MAIN BATTERY CABLE
MAIN BATTERY CABLE
HYBRID
P112
HYBRID
SYSTEM
BATTERY CONTROL
COMPONENTS
NO.1 BATTERY CARRIER CATCH BRACKET
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
BATTERY COVER
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
PROTECTOR
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
MAIN BATTERY CABLE
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
NO. 1 WIRE
HARNESS
PROTECTOR
COVER
TERMINAL COVER
TERMINAL COVER
5.6 (57, 50 in.*lbf)
HB
5.6 (57, 50 in.*lbf)
5.4 (55, 48 in.*lbf)
NO. 2 MAIN BATTERY CABLE
NO. 3 WIRE HARNESS
PROTECTOR COVER
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
5.4 (55, 48 in.*lbf)
NO. 3 BATTERY CARRIER CUSHION
A131339E01
HB–102
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – MAIN BATTERY CABLE
REMOVAL
CAUTION:
• When working on the high voltage systems, always
wear insulating gloves.
• Keep the removed service plug in your pocket to
prevent other technicians from reconnecting it while
you are servicing the vehicle.
• After removing the service plug grip, do not touch the
high voltage connectors and terminals for 5 minutes.
NOTICE:
After removing the service plug grip, do not operate the
power switch as it may damage the hybrid vehicle
control ECU.
1.
PRECAUTION
CAUTION:
The hybrid system uses high voltage circuits, so
improper handling could cause an electric shock or
leakage. During service (including installation/
removal, inspection and replacement of parts), be
sure to follow the procedures (see page HB-77).
2.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
3.
REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-4)
4.
REMOVE REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
5.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
6.
REMOVE SERVICE PLUG GRIP (See page HB-154)
7.
REMOVE HV BATTERY ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the HV battery from the vehicle (see page
HB-88).
8.
REMOVE BATTERY COVER (See page HB-93)
9.
REMOVE NO. 1 WIRE HARNESS PROTECTOR
COVER
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
HB
No. 1 Wire Harness Protector Cover
10. REMOVE NO. 3 WIRE HARNESS PROTECTOR
COVER
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
No. 3 Wire Harness Protector Cover
A083582E02
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – MAIN BATTERY CABLE
HB–103
11. REMOVE NO. 3 BATTERY CARRIER CUSHION
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(a) Peel off the bonded parts, then remove the battery
carrier cushion.
Bonded Parts
A077542E01
12. REMOVE MAIN BATTERY CABLE
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(a) Remove the terminal cover shown in the illustration.
Terminal Cover
A125183E01
(b) Remove the nut, then disconnect the aluminum
shield wire.
(c) Remove the nut, then disconnect the main battery
cable from the No. 3 system main relay.
(d) Remove the nut, then disconnect the main battery
cable from the No. 2 frame wire.
(e) Remove the main battery cable from the HV battery.
Aluminum Shield Wire
HB
Main Battery Cable
A083551E01
13. REMOVE NO. 2 MAIN BATTERY CABLE
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(a) Remove the terminal cover shown in the illustration.
Terminal Cover
A083580E01
HB–104
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – MAIN BATTERY CABLE
(b) Remove the nut, then disconnect the system main
relay terminal and No. 2 main battery cable from the
No. 2 system main relay.
(c) Remove the nut, then disconnect the No. 2 main
battery cable from the frame wire.
(d) Remove the No. 2 main battery cable from the HV
battery.
No. 2 Main Battery Cable
System Main Relay Terminal
A083566E02
INSTALLATION
No. 2 Main Battery Cable
1.
System Main Relay Terminal
A083566E02
INSTALL NO. 2 MAIN BATTERY CABLE
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(a) Temporarily install the No. 2 main battery cable to
the HV battery.
(b) Install the No. 2 main battery cable to the No. 2
frame wire with a new nut.
Torque: 5.4 N*m (55 kgf*cm, 48 in.*lbf)
(c) Temporarily install the main battery cable and
system main relay terminal, in that order, to the No.
2 system main relay, then tighten the new nut.
Torque: 5.6 N*m (57 kgf*cm, 50 in.*lbf)
(d) Install the terminal cover shown in the illustration.
HB
Terminal Cover
A083580E01
2.
Aluminum Shield Wire
Main Battery Cable
A083551E01
INSTALL MAIN BATTERY CABLE
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(a) Temporarily install the main battery cable to the HV
battery.
(b) Install the main battery cable to the No. 2 frame wire
with a new nut.
Torque: 5.4 N*m (55 kgf*cm, 48 in.*lbf)
(c) Install the main battery cable to the No. 3 system
main relay with a new nut.
Torque: 5.6 N*m (57 kgf*cm, 50 in.*lbf)
(d) Install the aluminum shield wire with a new nut.
Torque: 3.3 N*m (34 kgf*cm, 29 in.*lbf)
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – MAIN BATTERY CABLE
HB–105
(e) Install the terminal cover shown in the illustration.
Terminal Cover
A083579E01
3.
INSTALL NO. 3 BATTERY CARRIER CUSHION
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(a) Degrease and clean the installation surface of the
battery carrier cushion.
(b) Install a new battery carrier cushion.
4.
INSTALL NO. 1 WIRE HARNESS PROTECTOR
COVER
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
5.
INSTALL NO. 3 WIRE HARNESS PROTECTOR
COVER
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
6.
INSTALL BATTERY COVER (See page HB-95)
7.
INSTALL HV BATTERY ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the HV battery to the vehicle (see page HB96).
8.
INSTALL SERVICE PLUG GRIP (See page HB-114)
9.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL (See page CH-7)
Bonded Parts
A077542E01
No. 1 Wire Harness Protector Cover
No. 3 Wire Harness Protector Cover
A083582E02
10. INSTALL REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
11. INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-8)
12. INSTALL REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
13. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
HB
HB–106
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – FRAME WIRE
FRAME WIRE
HYBRID
P112
HYBRID
SYSTEM
BATTERY CONTROL
COMPONENTS
NO. 1 BATTERY CARRIER CATCH BRACKET
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
BATTERY COVER
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
PROTECTOR
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
MAIN BATTERY CABLE
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
NO. 1 WIRE
HARNESS
PROTECTOR
COVER
HB
TERMINAL COVER
TERMINAL COVER
5.6 (57, 50 in.*lbf)
5.6 (57, 50 in.*lbf)
5.4 (55, 48 in.*lbf)
NO. 2 MAIN BATTERY CABLE
NO. 3 WIRE HARNESS
PROTECTOR COVER
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
5.4 (55, 48 in.*lbf)
NO. 3 BATTERY CARRIER CUSHION
A131339E02
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – FRAME WIRE
HB–107
NO. 2 FRAME WIRE
5.4 (55, 48 in.*lbf)
HB
x 26
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A131340E01
HB–108
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – FRAME WIRE
REMOVAL
CAUTION:
• When working on the high voltage systems, always
wear insulating gloves.
• Keep the removed service plug in your pocket to
prevent other technicians from reconnecting it while
you are servicing the vehicle.
• After removing the service plug grip, do not touch the
high voltage connectors and terminals for 5 minutes.
NOTICE:
After removing the service plug grip, do not operate the
power switch as it may damage the hybrid vehicle
control ECU.
1.
PRECAUTION
CAUTION:
The hybrid system uses high voltage circuits, so
improper handling could cause an electric shock or
leakage. During service (including installation/
removal, inspection and replacement of parts), be
sure to follow the procedures (see page HB-77).
2.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
3.
REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-4)
4.
REMOVE REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
5.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
6.
REMOVE SERVICE PLUG GRIP (See page HB-154)
7.
REMOVE HV BATTERY ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the HV battery from the vehicle (see page
HB-88).
8.
REMOVE BATTERY COVER (See page HB-93)
9.
REMOVE NO. 1 WIRE HARNESS PROTECTOR
COVER (See page HB-102)
HB
10. REMOVE NO. 3 WIRE HARNESS PROTECTOR
COVER (See page HB-102)
11. REMOVE NO. 3 BATTERY CARRIER CUSHION (See
page HB-103)
12. REMOVE MAIN BATTERY CABLE (See page HB-103)
13. REMOVE NO. 2 MAIN BATTERY CABLE (See page
HB-103)
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – FRAME WIRE
HB–109
14. REMOVE NO. 2 FRAME WIRE
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(a) Disconnect the temperature sensor connector from
the battery ECU.
(b) Remove the clamp, then disconnect the No. 2 frame
wire connector from the battery ECU.
Clamp
A077536E01
(c) Remove the 26 nuts and No. 2 frame wire.
A089187E01
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL NO. 2 FRAME WIRE
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(a) Install the No. 2 frame wire with new 26 nuts.
Torque: 5.4 N*m (55 kgf*cm, 48 in.*lbf)
A089187E01
(b) Connect the No. 2 frame wire connector to the
battery ECU, then connect the clamp.
(c) Connect the temperature sensor connector to the
battery ECU.
Clamp
2.
INSTALL NO. 2 MAIN BATTERY CABLE (See page
HB-104)
3.
INSTALL MAIN BATTERY CABLE (See page HB-104)
4.
INSTALL NO. 3 BATTERY CARRIER CUSHION (See
page HB-105)
5.
INSTALL NO. 1 WIRE HARNESS PROTECTOR
COVER (See page HB-105)
6.
INSTALL NO. 3 WIRE HARNESS PROTECTOR
COVER (See page HB-105)
7.
INSTALL BATTERY COVER (See page HB-95)
8.
INSTALL HV BATTERY ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the HV battery to the vehicle (see page HB96).
9.
INSTALL SERVICE PLUG GRIP (See page HB-154)
A077536E02
HB
HB–110
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – FRAME WIRE
10. CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL (See page CH-7)
11. INSTALL REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
12. INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-8)
13. INSTALL REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
14. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
HB
HB–111
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – BATTERY PLUG
BATTERY PLUG
HYBRID
P112
HYBRID
SYSTEM
BATTERY CONTROL
COMPONENTS
NO. 1 BATTERY CARRIER
CATCH BRACKET
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
BATTERY COVER
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
PROTECTOR
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
5.4 (55, 48 in.*lbf)
NO. 4 WIRE HARNESS
PROTECTOR COVER
BATTERY CLAMP PAD
NO. 1 WIRE HARNESS
PROTECTOR COVER
SERVICE PLUG GRIP
5.4 (55, 48 in.*lbf)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A131341E01
HB
HB–112
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – BATTERY PLUG
REMOVAL
CAUTION:
• When working on the high voltage systems, always
wear insulating gloves.
• Keep the removed service plug in your pocket to
prevent other technicians from reconnecting it while
you are servicing the vehicle.
• After removing the service plug grip, do not touch the
high voltage connectors and terminals for 5 minutes.
NOTICE:
After removing the service plug grip, do not operate the
power switch as it may damage the hybrid vehicle
control ECU.
1.
PRECAUTION
CAUTION:
The hybrid system uses high voltage circuits, so
improper handling could cause an electric shock or
leakage. During service (including installation/
removal, inspection and replacement of parts), be
sure to follow the procedures (see page HB-77).
2.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
3.
REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-4)
4.
REMOVE REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
5.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
6.
REMOVE SERVICE PLUG GRIP (See page HB-154)
7.
REMOVE HV BATTERY ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the HV battery from the vehicle (see page
HB-88).
8.
REMOVE BATTERY COVER (See page HB-93)
9.
REMOVE BATTERY CLAMP PAD
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(a) Peel off the bonded parts, then remove the battery
clamp pad (the battery carrier cushion).
HB
Bonded Parts
A077541E01
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – BATTERY PLUG
HB–113
10. REMOVE NO. 1 WIRE HARNESS PROTECTOR
COVER
(a) Open the wire harness protector cover.
(b) Remove the 2 nuts, then disconnect the service
plug.
(c) Remove the wire harness protector cover.
No. 4 Wire Harness Protector Cover
A077550E02
Connector Clamp
11. REMOVE BATTERY PLUG
(a) Disconnect the connector clamp.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts, then disconnect the service
plug from the upper battery carrier.
A077543E01
(c) Open the wire harness protector cover as shown in
the illustration. Then remove the service plug from
the junction block.
HB
Junction Block
Wire Harness
Protector Cover
A077544E03
INSPECTION
1.
A092566E01
INSPECT BATTERY PLUG
(a) Check the resistance.
(1) Measure the resistance between the terminals.
Standard resistance:
10 kΩ or higher
If the result is not as specified, replace the
battery plug.
HB–114
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – BATTERY PLUG
(2) Install the service plug grip to the socket.
(3) Measure the resistance between the terminals.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the
battery plug.
Service Plug Grip
Socket
A092575E01
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL BATTERY PLUG
(a) Temporarily fasten the service plug.
(b) Install the service plug to the upper battery carrier
with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 5.4 N*m (55 kgf*cm, 48 in.*lbf)
(c) Assemble the connector clamp.
2.
INSTALL NO. 1 WIRE HARNESS PROTECTOR
COVER
(a) Temporarily fasten the wire harness protector cover
to the service plug.
(b) Install the wiring harness protector cover through
the service plug with 2 new nuts.
Torque: 5.4 N*m (55 kgf*cm, 48 in.*lbf)
3.
INSTALL BATTERY CLAMP PAD
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(a) Install a new clamp pad (the battery carrier
cushion).
4.
INSTALL BATTERY COVER (See page HB-95)
5.
INSTALL HV BATTERY ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the HV battery to the vehicle (see page HB96).
6.
INSTALL SERVICE PLUG GRIP (See page HB-154)
7.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL (See page CH-7)
8.
INSTALL REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
9.
INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-8)
Connector Clamp
A077543E01
HB
Bonded Parts
A077541E01
10. INSTALL REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
11. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
HB–115
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – JUNCTION BLOCK
JUNCTION BLOCK
HYBRID
P112
HYBRID
SYSTEM
BATTERY CONTROL
COMPONENTS
NO. 1 BATTERY CARRIER
CATCH BRACKET
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
BATTERY COVER
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
PROTECTOR
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
HB
NO. 2 WIRE HARNESS
PROTECTOR COVER
5.4 (55, 48 in.*lbf)
x 26
NO. 4 WRE HARNESS
PROTECTOR COVER
JUNCTION BLOCK
5.4 (55, 48 in.*lbf)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A131342E01
HB–116
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – JUNCTION BLOCK
REMOVAL
CAUTION:
• When working on the high voltage systems, always
wear insulating gloves.
• Keep the removed service plug in your pocket to
prevent other technicians from reconnecting it while
you are servicing the vehicle.
• After removing the service plug grip, do not touch the
high voltage connectors and terminals for 5 minutes.
NOTICE:
After removing the service plug grip, do not operate the
power switch as it may damage the hybrid vehicle
control ECU.
1.
PRECAUTION
CAUTION:
The hybrid system uses high voltage circuits, so
improper handling could cause an electric shock or
leakage. During service (including installation/
removal, inspection and replacement of parts), be
sure to follow the procedures (see page HB-77).
2.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
3.
REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-4)
4.
REMOVE REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
5.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
6.
REMOVE SERVICE PLUG GRIP (See page HB-154)
7.
REMOVE HV BATTERY ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the HV battery from the vehicle (see page
HB-88).
8.
REMOVE BATTERY COVER (See page HB-93)
9.
REMOVE NO. 2 WIRE HARNESS PROTECTOR
COVER
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
HB
No. 4 Wire Harness Protector Cover
No. 2 Wire Harness Protector Cover
A083565E02
10. REMOVE NO. 4 WIRE HARNESS PROTECTOR
COVER
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – JUNCTION BLOCK
HB–117
11. REMOVE JUNCTION BLOCK
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(a) Remove the 26 nuts and junction block.
A083549E01
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL JUNCTION BLOCK
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(a) Install the junction block assembly with 26 new nuts.
Torque: 5.4 N*m (55 kgf*cm, 48 in.*lbf)
2.
INSTALL NO. 2 WIRE HARNESS PROTECTOR
COVER
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
3.
INSTALL NO. 4 WIRE HARNESS PROTECTOR
COVER
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
4.
INSTALL BATTERY COVER (See page HB-95)
5.
INSTALL HV BATTERY ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the HV battery to the vehicle (see page HB96).
6.
INSTALL SERVICE PLUG GRIP (See page HB-154)
7.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL (See page CH-7)
8.
INSTALL REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
9.
INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-8)
A083549E01
No. 4 Wire Harness Protector Cover
No. 2 Wire Harness Protector Cover
A083565E02
10. INSTALL REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
11. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
HB
HB–118
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
HYBRID
P112
HYBRID
SYSTEM
BATTERY CONTROL
COMPONENTS
REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD
REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD
REAR DECK FLOOR BOX
HB
6.0 (61, 53 in.*lbf)
NEGATIVE BATTERY
CABLE
SERVICE PLUG GRIP
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A124443E10
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
HB–119
TONNEAU COVER
REAR DECK TRIM COVER
LUGGAGE HOLD BELT STRIKER
LUGGAGE HOLD BELT
STRIKER
HB
REAR NO. 1 FLOOR BOARD
REAR SEAT CUSHION
ASSEMBLY
A124453E04
HB–120
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
REAR NO. 4 FLOOR BOARD
28 (286, 21)
28 (286, 21)
28 (286, 21)
28 (286, 21)
BATTERY CARRIER BRACKET
DECK FLOOR BOX LH
DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL LH
HB
REAR SIDE SEAT BACK FRAME LH
LUGGAGE HOLD BELT STRIKER
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A131403E01
HB–121
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
NO. 6 BATTERY CARRIER PANEL
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
JUNCTION TERMINAL
5.6 (57, 50 in.*lbf)
3.4 (35, 30 in.*lbf)
NO. 1 SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
SYSTEM MAIN
RESISTOR
WIRE HARNESS
NO. 2 SYSTEM
MAIN RELAY
3.4 (35, 30 in.*lbf)
3.4 (35, 30 in.*lbf)
3.4 (35, 30 in.*lbf)
5.6 (57, 50 in.*lbf)
3.4 (35, 30 in.*lbf)
FRAME WIRE
NO. 3 SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A131343E01
HB
HB–122
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
REMOVAL
CAUTION:
• When working on the high voltage systems, always
wear insulating gloves.
• Keep the removed service plug in your pocket to
prevent other technicians from reconnecting it while
you are servicing the vehicle.
• After removing the service plug grip, do not touch the
high voltage connectors and terminals for 5 minutes.
NOTICE:
After removing the service plug grip, do not operate the
power switch as it may damage the hybrid vehicle
control ECU.
1.
PRECAUTION
CAUTION:
The hybrid system uses high voltage circuits, so
improper handling could cause an electric shock or
leakage. During service (including installation/
removal, inspection and replacement of parts), be
sure to follow the procedures (see page HB-77 ).
2.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
3.
REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-4)
4.
REMOVE REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
5.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
6.
REMOVE SERVICE PLUG GRIP (See page HB-154)
7.
REMOVE REAR DECK TRIM COVER (See page HB88)
8.
REMOVE TONNEAU COVER (See page HB-89)
9.
REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY (See
page HB-89)
HB
10. REMOVE REAR NO. 1 FLOOR BOARD (See page HB89)
11. REMOVE REAR SIDE SEAT BACK FRAME LH (See
page HB-89)
12. REMOVE REAR NO. 4 FLOOR BOARD (See page HB90)
13. REMOVE DECK FLOOR BOX LH (See page HB-90)
14. REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL LH (See page HB90)
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
HB–123
15. REMOVE BATTERY CARRIER BRACKET (See page
HB-91)
16. REMOVE NO. 6 BATTERY CARRIER PANEL (See
page HB-91)
17. REMOVE JUNCTION TERMINAL (See page HB-92)
18. SEPARATE FRAME WIRE (See page HB-92)
19. REMOVE NO. 2 SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(a) Remove the 2 terminal covers.
Terminal Covers
A083581E01
(b) Remove the nut, then disconnect the system main
battery relay terminal and main battery cable.
Main Battery Cable
System Main
Battery Relay
Terminal
HB
A077540E03
(c) Disconnect the connector.
(d) Remove the 2 nuts and No. 2 system main relay.
Connector
A077539E01
HB–124
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
20. REMOVE NO. 3 SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
NOTICE:
Wear insulating gloves.
(a) Remove the nut, then disconnect the main battery
cable.
(b) Remove the 2 nuts, then disconnect the No. 3
system main relay.
(c) Disconnect the connector and remove the No. 3
system main relay.
Main Battery Cable
Connector
A077538E01
21. REMOVE NO. 1 SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the nut, then disconnect the ground
terminal.
(c) Disconnect the 2 clamps.
(d) Remove the system main relay connector.
(e) Remove the 2 bolts and No. 1 system main relay.
Clamp
Ground Terminal
System Main Relay Connector
No. 1 System Main Relay
A092580E01
HB
HB–125
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT NO. 1 SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
NOTICE:
Connectors B and C have the same shape. Identify
each connector by the wire harness length (L) and
the wire harness color on the terminal 2 side.
Connector
Wire Harness Length
(L)
Wire Harness Color
B
Short
Yellow
C
Long
Black
Positive Terminal
GND
CONT2
2 1
L
Connetor B
Negative
Terminal
CONT1
L
2 1
CONT3
2 1
4 3
GND Terminal
Connector C
CONT2
CONT3
Connector A
GND
A131261E01
(a) Check the resistance.
(1) Measure the resistance between the
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Positive terminal - Negative terminal
10 kΩ or higher
A-2 (CONT2) - B-2 (CONT2)
Below 1 Ω
A-3 (CONT3) - C-2 (CONT3)
Below 1 Ω
B-1 (GND) - GND
Below 1 Ω
C-1 (GND) - GND
Below 1 Ω
If the results are not as specified, replace the
No. 1 system main relay.
HB
HB–126
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
(2) Apply battery voltage between the GND
terminal and CONT1 terminal of the connector
A, then measure the resistance between the
positive and negative terminals.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
If the results are not as specified, replace the
No. 1 system main relay.
(b) Inspect the resistance.
(1) Measure the resistance between the GND
terminal and CONT1 terminal of the connector
A.
Standard resistance:
70 to 160 kΩ
If the the results are not as specified, replace
the No. 1 system main relay.
Negative Terminal
Positive Terminal
2.
INSPECT NO. 2 SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
(a) Install the 2 installed nuts to the negative and
positive terminals.
Torque: 5.6 N*m (57 kgf*cm, 50 in.*lbf)
(b) Check the resistance.
(1) Measure the resistance between the positive
and negative terminals.
Standard resistance:
10 kΩ or higher
If the result is not as specified, replace the No.
2 system main relay.
(2) Apply battery voltage between the connector
terminals, then measure the resistance
between the positive and negative terminals.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the No.
2 system main relay.
(c) Inspect the resistance.
(1) Measure the resistance between the connector
terminals.
Standard resistance:
20 to 50 kΩ
If the result is not as specified, replace the No.
2 system main relay.
3.
INSPECT NO. 3 SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
(a) Install the 2 installed nuts to the negative and
positive terminals.
Torque: 5.6 N*m (57 kgf*cm, 50 in.*lbf)
(b) Check the resistance.
(1) Measure the resistance between the positive
and negative terminals.
Standard resistance:
10 kΩ or higher
If the result is not as specified, replace the No.
3 system main relay.
A077579E01
HB
Negative Terminal
Positive Terminal
A077579E01
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
HB–127
(2) Apply battery voltage between the connector
terminals, then measure the resistance
between the positive and negative terminals.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the No.
3 system main relay.
(c) Inspect the resistance.
(1) Measure the resistance between the connector
terminals.
Standard resistance:
20 to 50 kΩ
If the result is not as specified, replace the No.
3 system main relay.
HB
HB–128
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL NO. 1 SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(a) Install the No. 1 system main relay with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 3.4 N*m (35 kgf*cm, 30 in.*lbf)
(b) Connect the system main relay connector.
Ground Terminal
Clamp
System Main Relay Connector
No. 1 System Main Relay
A092580E01
(c) Connect the 2 clamps, then install the system main
relay sub wiring harness to the upper battery carrier.
(d) Install the ground terminal with the nut.
Torque: 5.6 N*m (57 kgf*cm, 50 in.*lbf)
(e) Install the connector.
Main Battery Cable
HB
2.
INSTALL NO. 3 SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(a) Connect the connector, then temporarily install the
No. 3 system main relay.
(b) Install the No. 3 system main relay with 2 new nuts.
Torque: 3.4 N*m (35 kgf*cm, 30 in.*lbf)
(c) Install the main battery cable with the nut.
Torque: 5.6 N*m (57 kgf*cm, 50 in.*lbf)
3.
INSTALL NO. 2 SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(a) Install the No. 2 system main relay with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 3.4 N*m (35 kgf*cm, 30 in.*lbf)
(b) Connect the connector.
Connector
A077538E01
Connector
A077539E01
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
HB–129
(c) Temporarily install the system main relay terminal
and No. 2 main battery cable terminal, in that order,
and tighten a new nut.
Torque: 5.6 N*m (57 kgf*cm, 50 in.*lbf)
(d) Install the 2 terminal covers.
Main Battery Cable
4.
System Main
Battery Relay
Terminal
INSPECT CONTACT CONDITION
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(a) Check that all the wire harnesses are correctly and
securely connected on the upper battery carrier.
A077540E03
System Main Resistor
No. 1 System Main Relay
Aluminum Shield Wire
Clamp
No. 2 Main Battery Cable
Main Battery Cable
A093049E01
NOTICE:
Make sure that the connectors and clamps are
connected exactly the same as the illustration
above. If any of them is different, correct it
immediately.
5.
INSTALL FRAME WIRE (See page HB-96)
6.
INSTALL JUNCTION TERMINAL (See page HB-96)
7.
INSTALL NO. 6 BATTERY CARRIER PANEL (See
page HB-97)
8.
INSTALL BATTERY CARRIER BRACKET (See page
HB-97)
9.
INSTALL DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL LH (See page HB98)
10. INSTALL DECK FLOOR BOX LH (See page HB-98)
11. INSTALL REAR NO. 4 FLOOR BOARD (See page HB98)
12. INSTALL REAR SIDE SEAT BACK FRAME LH (See
page HB-99)
HB
HB–130
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
13. INSTALL REAR NO. 1 FLOOR BOARD (See page HB99)
14. INSTALL REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY (See
page HB-99)
15. INSTALL TONNEAU COVER (See page HB-99)
16. INSTALL REAR DECK TRIM COVER (See page HB99)
17. INSTALL SERVICE PLUG GRIP (See page HB-154)
18. CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL (See page CH-7)
19. INSTALL REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
20. INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-8)
21. INSTALL REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
22. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
HB
HB–130
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – BATTERY BLOWER RELAY
BATTERY BLOWER RELAY
3
5
1
2
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
5
2
1
3
B060778E14
INSPECT BATTERY BLOWER RELAY
(a) Measure the battery blower relay resistance.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to
terminals 1 and 2)
If the result is not as specified, replace the relay.
HB
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – SYSTEM MAIN RESISTOR
HB–131
SYSTEM MAIN RESISTOR
HYBRID
P112
HYBRID
SYSTEM
BATTERY CONTROL
COMPONENTS
REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD
REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD
REAR DECK FLOOR BOX
HB
6.0 (61, 53 in.*lbf)
NEGATIVE
BATTERY CABLE
SERVICE PLUG GRIP
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A124443E11
HB–132
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – SYSTEM MAIN RESISTOR
TONNEAU COVER
REAR DECK TRIM COVER
LUGGAGE HOLD BELT STRIKER
LUGGAGE HOLD BELT
STRIKER
HB
REAR NO. 1 FLOOR BOARD
REAR SEAT CUSHION
ASSEMBLY
A124453E05
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – SYSTEM MAIN RESISTOR
HB–133
REAR NO. 4 FLOOR BOARD
28 (286, 21)
28 (286, 21)
28 (286, 21)
28 (286, 21)
BATTERY CARRIER BRACKET
DECK FLOOR BOX LH
DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL LH
HB
REAR SIDE SEAT BACK FRAME LH
LUGGAGE HOLD BELT STRIKER
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A131403E02
HB–134
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – SYSTEM MAIN RESISTOR
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
NO. 6 BATTERY CARRIER PANEL
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
JUNCTION TERMINAL
3.4 (35, 30 in.*lbf)
HB
SYSTEM MAIN RESISTOR
5.6 (57, 50 in.*lbf)
FRAME WIRE
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
A131344E01
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – SYSTEM MAIN RESISTOR
HB–135
REMOVAL
CAUTION:
• When working on the high voltage systems, always
wear insulating gloves.
• Keep the removed service plug in your pocket to
prevent other technicians from reconnecting it while
you are servicing the vehicle.
• After removing the service plug grip, do not touch the
high voltage connectors and terminals for 5 minutes.
NOTICE:
After removing the service plug grip, do not operate the
power switch as it may damage the hybrid vehicle
control ECU.
1.
PRECAUTION
CAUTION:
The hybrid system uses high voltage circuits, so
improper handling could cause an electric shock or
leakage. During service (including installation/
removal, inspection and replacement of parts), be
sure to follow the procedures (see page HB-77).
2.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
3.
REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-4)
4.
REMOVE REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
5.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
6.
REMOVE SERVICE PLUG GRIP (See page HB-154)
7.
REMOVE REAR DECK TRIM COVER (See page HB88)
8.
REMOVE TONNEAU COVER (See page HB-89)
9.
REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY (See
page HB-89)
10. REMOVE REAR NO. 1 FLOOR BOARD (See page HB89)
11. REMOVE REAR SIDE SEAT BACK FRAME LH (See
page HB-89)
12. REMOVE REAR NO. 4 FLOOR BOARD (See page HB90)
13. REMOVE DECK FLOOR BOX LH (See page HB-90)
14. REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL LH (See page HB90)
HB
HB–136
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – SYSTEM MAIN RESISTOR
15. REMOVE BATTERY CARRIER BRACKET (See page
HB-91)
16. REMOVE NO. 6 BATTERY CARRIER PANEL (See
page HB-91)
17. REMOVE JUNCTION TERMINAL (See page HB-92)
18. DISCONNECT FRAME WIRE
CAUTION:
• Wear insulating gloves.
• Insulate the removed terminals with insulating
tape.
(a) Remove the nut, then disconnect the frame wire
from the No. 2 system main relay.
No. 2 System
Main Relay
A088629E01
System Main Resistor
19. REMOVE SYSTEM MAIN RESISTOR
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(a) Disconnect the connector from the No. 1 system
main relay.
(b) Remove the bolt and system main resistor.
No. 1 System Main Relay
A083568E01
INSPECTION
1.
HB
INSPECT SYSTEM MAIN RESISTOR
(a) Measure the resistance between the terminals.
Standard resistance:
18 to 22 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the system
main resistor.
A077581E01
System Main Resistor
No. 1 System Main Relay
A083568E01
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL SYSTEM MAIN RESISTOR
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(a) Install the system main resistor with the bolt.
Torque: 3.4 N*m (35 kgf*cm, 30 in.*lbf)
(b) Install the connector to the No. 1 system main relay.
2.
INSPECT CONTACT CONDITION (See page HB-128)
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – SYSTEM MAIN RESISTOR
No. 2 System
Main Relay
HB–137
3.
INSTALL FRAME WIRE
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(a) Temporarily install the system main resistor terminal
and frame wire, in that order, and tighten a new nut.
Torque: 5.6 N*m (57 kgf*cm, 50 in.*lbf)
4.
INSTALL JUNCTION TERMINAL (See page HB-96)
5.
INSTALL NO. 6 BATTERY CARRIER PANEL (See
page HB-97)
6.
INSTALL BATTERY CARRIER BRACKET (See page
HB-97)
7.
INSTALL DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL LH (See page HB98)
8.
INSTALL DECK FLOOR BOX LH (See page HB-98)
9.
INSTALL REAR NO. 4 FLOOR BOARD (See page HB98)
A088629E01
10. INSTALL REAR SIDE SEAT BACK FRAME LH (See
page HB-99)
11. INSTALL REAR NO. 1 FLOOR BOARD (See page HB99)
12. INSTALL REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY (See
page HB-99)
13. INSTALL TONNEAU COVER (See page HB-99)
14. INSTALL REAR DECK TRIM COVER (See page HB100)
15. INSTALL SERVICE PLUG GRIP (See page HB-154)
16. CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL (See page CH-7)
17. INSTALL REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
18. INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-8)
19. INSTALL REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
20. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
HB
HB–138
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – BATTERY CURRENT SENSOR
BATTERY CURRENT SENSOR
HYBRID
P112
HYBRID
SYSTEM
BATTERY CONTROL
COMPONENTS
REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD
REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD
REAR DECK FLOOR BOX
HB
6.0 (61, 53 in.*lbf)
NEGATIVE BATTERY
CABLE
SERVICE PLUG GRIP
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A124443E12
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – BATTERY CURRENT SENSOR
HB–139
TONNEAU COVER
REAR DECK TRIM COVER
LUGGAGE HOLD BELT STRIKER
LUGGAGE HOLD BELT
STRIKER
HB
REAR NO. 1 FLOOR BOARD
REAR SEAT CUSHION
ASSEMBLY
A124453E06
HB–140
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – BATTERY CURRENT SENSOR
28 (286, 21)
28 (286, 21)
28 (286, 21)
BATTERY CARRIER BRACKET
28 (286, 21)
28 (286, 21)
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
REAR NO. 4 FLOOR BOARD
NO. 6 BATTERY CARRIER PANEL
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
TERMINAL COVER
DECK FLOOR BOX LH
5.6 (55, 71 in.*lbf)
HB
MAIN BATTERY
CABLE
DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL LH
BATTERY CURRENT
SENSOR CONNECTOR
1.4 (14, 12 in.*lbf)
BATTERY CURRENT SENSOR
REAR SIDE SEAT BACK FRAME LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
LUGGAGE HOLD BELT STRIKER
Non-reusable part
A131405E01
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – BATTERY CURRENT SENSOR
HB–141
REMOVAL
CAUTION:
• When working on the high voltage systems, always
wear insulating gloves.
• Keep the removed service plug in your pocket to
prevent other technicians from reconnecting it while
you are servicing the vehicle.
• After removing the service plug grip, do not touch the
high voltage connectors and terminals for 5 minutes.
NOTICE:
After removing the service plug grip, do not operate the
power switch as it may damage the hybrid vehicle
control ECU.
1.
PRECAUTION
CAUTION:
The hybrid system uses high voltage circuits, so
improper handling could cause an electric shock or
leakage. During service (including installation/
removal, inspection and replacement of parts), be
sure to follow the procedures (see page HB-77).
2.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
3.
REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-4)
4.
REMOVE REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
5.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
6.
REMOVE SERVICE PLUG GRIP (See page HB-154)
7.
REMOVE REAR DECK TRIM COVER (See page HB88)
8.
REMOVE TONNEAU COVER (See page HB-89)
9.
REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY (See
page HB-89)
10. REMOVE REAR NO. 1 FLOOR BOARD (See page HB89)
11. REMOVE REAR SIDE SEAT BACK FRAME LH (See
page HB-89)
12. REMOVE REAR NO. 4 FLOOR BOARD (See page HB90)
13. REMOVE DECK FLOOR BOX LH (See page HB-90)
14. REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL LH (See page HB90)
HB
HB–142
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – BATTERY CURRENT SENSOR
15. REMOVE BATTERY CARRIER BRACKET (See page
HB-91)
16. REMOVE NO. 6 BATTERY CARRIER PANEL (See
page HB-91)
17. REMOVE BATTERY CURRENT SENSOR
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(a) Remove the terminal cover.
Terminal Cover
A083579E01
(b) Remove the nut, then disconnect the main battery
cable.
A083638E01
(c) Disconnect the connector.
(d) Remove the 2 screws and battery current sensor.
HB
Connector
A083564E01
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT BATTERY CURRENT SENSOR
(a) Inspect the resistance.
(1) Measure the resistance between terminals 1
(VIB) and 2 (GIB).
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
IB
GIB
VIB
A077580E01
Resistance
Positive probe to terminal 1 (VIB)
Negative probe to terminal 2 (GIB)
3.5 to 4.5 kΩ
Positive probe to terminal 2 (GIB)
Negative probe to terminal 1 (VIB)
5 to 7 kΩ
If the the results are not as specified, replace
the battery current sensor.
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – BATTERY CURRENT SENSOR
HB–143
(2) Measure the resistance between terminals 1
(VIB) and 3 (IB).
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Resistance
Positive probe to terminal 1 (VIB)
Negative probe to terminal 3 (IB)
3.5 to 4.5 kΩ
Positive probe to terminal 1 (VIB)
Negative probe to terminal 3 (IB)
5 to 7 kΩ
If the results are not as specified, replace the
battery current sensor.
(3) Measure the resistance between terminals 2
(GIB) and 3 (IB).
Standard resistance:
0.2 kΩ or less
NOTICE:
Even if the probes are changed around, the
resistance will not vary.
If the result is not as specified, replace the
battery current sensor.
INSTALLATION
1.
Connector
INSTALL BATTERY CURRENT SENSOR
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(a) Install the battery current sensor with the 2 screws.
Torque: 1.4 N*m (14 kgf*cm, 12 in.*lbf)
(b) Connect the connector.
A083564E01
(c) Install the main battery cable with a new nut.
Torque: 5.6 N*m (57 kgf*cm, 50 in.*lbf)
A083638E01
(d) Install the terminal cover.
2.
INSTALL NO. 6 BATTERY CARRIER PANEL (See
page HB-97)
3.
INSTALL BATTERY CARRIER BRACKET (See page
HB-97)
4.
INSTALL DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL LH (See page HB98)
5.
INSTALL DECK FLOOR BOX LH (See page HB-98)
6.
INSTALL REAR NO. 4 FLOOR BOARD (See page HB98)
Terminal Cover
A083579E02
HB
HB–144
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – BATTERY CURRENT SENSOR
7.
INSTALL REAR SIDE SEAT BACK FRAME LH (See
page HB-99)
8.
INSTALL REAR NO. 1 FLOOR BOARD (See page HB99)
9.
INSTALL REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY (See
page HB-99)
10. INSTALL TONNEAU COVER (See page HB-99)
11. INSTALL REAR DECK TRIM COVER (See page HB100)
12. INSTALL SERVICE PLUG GRIP (See page HB-154)
13. CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL (See page CH-7)
14. INSTALL REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
15. INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-8)
16. INSTALL REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
17. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
HB
HB–145
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – BATTERY ECU
BATTERY ECU
HYBRID
P112
HYBRID
SYSTEM
BATTERY CONTROL
COMPONENTS
REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD
REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD
REAR DECK FLOOR BOX
HB
6.0 (61, 53 in.*lbf)
NEGATIVE BATTERY
CABLE
SERVICE PLUG GRIP
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A124443E13
HB–146
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – BATTERY ECU
TONNEAU COVER
REAR DECK TRIM COVER
LUGGAGE HOLD BELT STRIKER
LUGGAGE HOLD BELT
STRIKER
HB
REAR NO. 1 FLOOR BOARD
REAR SEAT CUSHION
ASSEMBLY
A124453E07
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – BATTERY ECU
HB–147
28 (286, 21)
28 (286, 21)
28 (286, 21)
BATTERY CARRIER BRACKET
28 (286, 21)
28 (286, 21)
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
REAR NO. 4 FLOOR BOARD
NO. 6 BATTERY CARRIER PANEL
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
JUNCTION TERMINAL
DECK FLOOR BOX LH
3.3 (34, 30 in.*lbf)
HB
BATTERY ECU
BATTERY ECU CONNECTOR
REAR SIDE SEAT BACK FRAME LH
LUGGAGE HOLD BELT STRIKER
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL LH
Non-reusable part
A131345E01
HB–148
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – BATTERY ECU
REMOVAL
CAUTION:
• When working on the high voltage systems, always
wear insulating gloves.
• Keep the removed service plug in your pocket to
prevent other technicians from reconnecting it while
you are servicing the vehicle.
• After removing the service plug grip, do not touch the
high voltage connectors and terminals for 5 minutes.
NOTICE:
After removing the service plug grip, do not operate the
power switch as it may damage the hybrid vehicle
control ECU.
1.
PRECAUTION
CAUTION:
The hybrid system uses high voltage circuits, so
improper handling could cause an electric shock or
leakage. During service (e.g. installing or removing
the parts, inspection, replacing the parts), be sure to
follow the procedures (see page HB-77).
2.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
3.
REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-4)
4.
REMOVE REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
5.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
6.
REMOVE SERVICE PLUG GRIP (See page HB-154)
7.
REMOVE REAR DECK TRIM COVER (See page HB88)
8.
REMOVE TONNEAU COVER (See page HB-89)
9.
REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY (See
page HB-89)
HB
10. REMOVE REAR NO. 1 FLOOR BOARD (See page HB89)
11. REMOVE REAR SIDE SEAT BACK FRAME LH (See
page HB-89)
12. REMOVE REAR NO. 4 FLOOR BOARD (See page HB90)
13. REMOVE DECK FLOOR BOX LH (See page HB-90)
14. REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL LH (See page HB90)
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – BATTERY ECU
HB–149
15. REMOVE BATTERY CARRIER BRACKET (See page
HB-91)
16. REMOVE NO. 6 BATTERY CARRIER PANEL (See
page HB-91)
17. REMOVE JUNCTION TERMINAL (See page HB-92)
System Main
Relay Connector
Battery ECU
Battery ECU Connector
A083606E02
18. REMOVE BATTERY ECU
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(a) Disconnect the system main relay connector.
CAUTION:
Insulate the disconnected connectors with
insulating tape.
(b) Disconnect the battery ECU connector.
CAUTION:
Insulate the disconnected connectors with
insulating tape.
(c) Disconnect the thermistor connector.
CAUTION:
Insulate the disconnected connectors with
insulating tape.
(d) Remove the clamp, then disconnect the No. 2 frame
wire connector.
CAUTION:
Insulate the disconnected connectors with
insulating tape.
(e) Remove the nut, then disconnect the aluminum
shield wire of the main battery cable.
Thermistor Connector
No. 2 Frame Wire Connector
HB
Clamp
Aluminum Shield Wire
A083605E01
(f)
Remove the 2 screws and battery ECU.
HB–150
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – BATTERY ECU
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL BATTERY ECU
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(a) Install the battery ECU with the 2 screws.
Torque: 3.3 N*m (34 kgf*cm, 29 in.*lbf)
Thermistor Connector
No. 2 Frame Wire Connector
Clamp
Aluminum Shield Wire
A083605E01
(b) Install the aluminum shield wire of the main battery
cable together with the battery ECU with a new nut.
Torque: 3.3 N*m (34 kgf*cm, 29 in.*lbf)
(c) Connect the clamp and No. 2 frame wire connector.
(d) Connect the thermistor connector.
System Main
Relay Connector
Battery ECU
Battery ECU Connector
HB
(e) Connect the system main relay connector.
2.
INSTALL JUNCTION TERMINAL (See page HB-96)
3.
INSTALL NO. 6 BATTERY CARRIER PANEL (See
page HB-97)
4.
INSTALL BATTERY CARRIER BRACKET (See page
HB-97)
5.
INSTALL DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL LH (See page HB98)
6.
INSTALL DECK FLOOR BOX LH (See page HB-98)
7.
INSTALL REAR NO. 4 FLOOR BOARD (See page HB98)
8.
INSTALL REAR SIDE SEAT BACK FRAME LH (See
page HB-99)
9.
INSTALL REAR NO. 1 FLOOR BOARD (See page HB99)
A083606E02
10. INSTALL REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY (See
page HB-99)
11. INSTALL TONNEAU COVER (See page HB-99)
12. INSTALL REAR DECK TRIM COVER (See page HB100)
13. INSTALL SERVICE PLUG GRIP (See page HB-154)
14. CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL (See page CH-7)
15. INSTALL REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – BATTERY ECU
HB–151
16. INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-8)
17. INSTALL REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
18. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
HB
HB–152
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – SERVICE PLUG GRIP
SERVICE PLUG GRIP
HYBRID
P112
HYBRID
SYSTEM
BATTERY CONTROL
COMPONENTS
REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD
REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD
REAR DECK FLOOR BOX
HB
6.0 (61, 53 in.*lbf)
NEGATIVE BATTERY
CABLE
SERVICE PLUG GRIP
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A124443E14
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – SERVICE PLUG GRIP
HB–153
REMOVAL
CAUTION:
• When working on the high voltage systems, always
wear insulating gloves.
• Keep the removed service plug in your pocket to
prevent other technicians from reconnecting it while
you are servicing the vehicle.
• After removing the service plug grip, do not touch the
high voltage connectors and terminals for 5 minutes.
NOTICE:
After removing the service plug grip, do not operate the
power switch as it may damage the hybrid vehicle
control ECU.
1.
PRECAUTION
CAUTION:
The hybrid system uses high voltage circuits, so
improper handling could cause an electric shock or
leakage. During service (including installation/
removal, inspection and replacement of parts), be
sure to follow the procedures (see page HB-77).
2.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD
(a) As shown in the illustration, turn the knob to release
the lock.
(b) Remove the rear floor board No. 2.
3.
REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX
(a) Remove the deck floor box rear shown in the
illustration.
4.
REMOVE REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD
(a) Remove the rear floor board shown in the
illustration.
FREE
FREE
LOCK
LOCK
A083547E01
A083546E01
A083544E01
HB
HB–154
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – SERVICE PLUG GRIP
5.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
(a) Disconnect the cable from the negative terminal of
the 12 V auxiliary battery.
6.
REMOVE SERVICE PLUG GRIP
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(a) Slide up the lever of the service plug grip. Remove
the service plug grip while turning the lever to the
left.
(b) Insulate the service plug with insulating tape.
7.
REMOVE BATTERY POSITIVE TERMINAL
(a) Remove the 2 joints shown in the illustration, then
remove the service plug grip cover.
A077567E01
Lever
A083545E03
HB
A092569E02
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and electric vehicle fuse.
A092570E01
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – SERVICE PLUG GRIP
HB–155
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL BATTERY POSITIVE TERMINAL
(a) Install the electric vehicle fuse with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 5.4 N*m (55 kgf*cm, 48 in.*lbf)
(b) Fit the 2 joints, then install the service plug grip
cover.
2.
INSTALL SERVICE PLUG GRIP
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(a) Joint the service plug grip with the HV battery.
(b) While pushing the service plug grip to the right,
rotate the lever to the right.
(c) Slide the lever down to lock the service plug grip in
place.
NOTICE:
• The service plug grip must be locked. If not, it
may cause DTCs to output.
• Do not operate the power switch when the
service plug grip is not properly locked. It
may damage the hybrid vehicle control ECU
in rare cases.
A089219
3.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL (See page CH-7)
4.
INSTALL REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
5.
INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-8)
6.
INSTALL REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
7.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
HB
HB–156
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – BATTERY BLOWER
BATTERY BLOWER
HYBRID
P112
HYBRID
SYSTEM
BATTERY CONTROL
COMPONENTS
REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD
REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD
REAR DECK FLOOR BOX
HB
6.0 (61, 53 in.*lbf)
NEGATIVE BATTERY
CABLE
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A124443E09
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – BATTERY BLOWER
HB–157
TONNEAU COVER
REAR DECK TRIM COVER
LUGGAGE HOLD BELT STRIKER
REAR NO. 1 FLOOR BOARD
HB
REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY
A124453E03
HB–158
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – BATTERY BLOWER
VENTILATOR DUCT INNER
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
BATTERY BLOWER
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
NO. 2 QUARTER VENT DUCT INNER
DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL RH
HB
LUGGAGE HOLD BELT STRIKER
REAR SIDE SEAT BACK FRAME RH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A124464E01
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – BATTERY BLOWER
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
Intelligent Tester
1.
CAN VIM
DLC3
A087542E04
2
HB–159
INSPECT BATTERY BLOWER
(a) Check the operation.
(1) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(3) Select the item:
DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD / HV BATTERY /
ACTIVE TEST / COOLING FAN SPD / 1 to 6.
NOTICE:
If the check results are normal, do not
perform the following check.
(b) Inspect the resistance.
(1) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB153).
(2) Disconnect the connector of the battery blower
motor.
(3) Measure the resistance between terminals 1
and 2 of the connector.
Standard resistance:
9 Ω or less
If the result is not as specified, replace the
battery blower assembly.
1
A090450E01
GND
A077570E02
(c) Inspect the voltage.
(1) Connect the connector of the blower motor.
(2) Measure the resistance between terminal 1
(GND) of the blower motor control connector
and body ground.
Standard resistance:
1 Ω or less
(3) Connect the negative terminal of the auxiliary
battery.
Torque: 6.0 N*m (61 kgf*cm, 53 in.*lbf)
(4) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(5) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(6) Select the item:
DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD / HV BATTERY /
ACTIVE TEST / COOLING FAN SPD / 1.
Intelligent Tester
CAN VIM
DLC3
A087542E04
HB
HB–160
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – BATTERY BLOWER
(7) Measure the voltage between terminals 1
(GND) of the blower motor connector and the
body ground.
Standard voltage:
9 to 14 V
NOTICE:
If there is no voltage, there may be a defect
in the power supply system relays or in the
wire harness.
(8) Turn the power switch OFF, then disconnect
the cable from the negative terminal of the
auxiliary battery.
(9) Disconnect the battery blower motor, battery
blower motor control, and connector of the
battery ECU.
A088189E01
Battery ECU
Battery Blower Motor
Battery Blower Motor Control
VM
B9
VM
B10
B11
A125181E02
HB
(10) Measure the resistance of the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
B9-1 - B10-4 (VM)
Below 1 Ω
B9-1 - B11-9 (VM)
Below 1 Ω
B9-1 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NOTICE:
If the result is not as specified, repair or
replace the wire harness and recheck the
blower motor operation by the intelligent
tester.
HB–161
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – BATTERY BLOWER
(11) Measure the resistance of the wire harness
side connectors.
Battery ECU
Holder Installed on No. 1 Battery Blower Relay
FCTL1
B14
B11
A125182E02
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
B14-2 - B11-10 (FCTL1)
Below 1 Ω
B14-2 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NOTICE:
If the result is not as specified, repair or
replace the wire harness and recheck the
blower motor operation by the intelligent
tester.
(12) Reconnect all the disconnected connectors.
NOTICE:
Do not connect the service plug grip.
(13) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(14) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(15) Select the item:
DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD / HV BATTERY /
ACTIVE TEST / COOLING FAN SPD / 1.
Intelligent Tester
CAN VIM
DLC3
A087542E04
SI
GND
A077572E01
(16) Measure the voltage between terminals 1
(GND) and 2 (SI) of the battery blower motor
control.
Standard voltage:
1 V or more
NOTICE:
If the result is not as specified, repair or
replace the wire harness and recheck the
blower motor operation by the intelligent
tester.
HB
HB–162
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – BATTERY BLOWER
(17) Measure the voltage between the terminals on
the blower motor connector.
Standard voltage:
2 to 4 V
NOTICE:
If the result is not as specified, repair or
replace the wire harness and recheck the
blower motor operation by the intelligent
tester.
A088189E01
VM
GND
A077572E02
HB
(18) Measure the voltage between terminals 1
(GND) and 4 (VM) of the blower motor control.
HINT:
A = (Measured voltage between terminals 1
(GND) of the blower motor connector and the
body ground.)
Standard condition:
A - 4 V to A - 2 V
NOTICE:
If the result is not as specified, repair or
replace the wire harness and recheck the
blower motor operation by the intelligent
tester.
(19) Recheck the blower motor operation by the
intelligent tester, and perform the inspection
again.
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – BATTERY BLOWER
HB–163
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
2.
REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-4)
3.
REMOVE REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
4.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
5.
REMOVE REAR DECK TRIM COVER (See page HB88)
6.
REMOVE TONNEAU COVER (See page HB-89)
7.
REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY (See
page HB-89)
8.
REMOVE REAR NO. 1 FLOOR BOARD (See page HB89)
9.
REMOVE REAR SIDE SEAT BACK FRAME RH (See
page HB-89)
10. REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL RH (See page HB90)
11. REMOVE NO. 2 QUARTER VENT DUCT INNER (See
page HB-91)
12. REMOVE VENTILATOR DUCT INNER
(a) Remove the 3 clips and ventilator duct inner.
A083529E01
Connector
Clamp
A083526E01
13. REMOVE BATTERY BLOWER
(a) Remove the 3 nuts, then disconnect the battery
blower assembly from the vehicle.
(b) Remove the connector, clamp and battery blower.
HB
HB–164
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL – BATTERY BLOWER
INSTALLATION
Connector
1.
INSTALL BATTERY BLOWER
(a) Connect the connector to the battery blower.
(b) Install the clamp on the battery blower.
(c) Install the battery blower with the 3 nuts.
Torque: 5.0 N*m (51 kgf*cm, 44 in.*lbf)
2.
INSTALL VENTILATOR DUCT INNER
(a) Install the ventilator duct inner with the 3 clips.
3.
INSTALL NO. 2 QUARTER VENT DUCT INNER (See
page HB-97)
4.
INSTALL DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL RH (See page HB98)
5.
INSTALL REAR SIDE SEAT BACK FRAME RH (See
page HB-99)
6.
INSTALL REAR NO. 1 FLOOR BOARD (See page HB99)
7.
INSTALL REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY (See
page HB-99)
8.
INSTALL TONNEAU COVER (See page HB-99)
9.
INSTALL REAR DECK TRIM COVER (See page HB100)
Clamp
A083526E01
A083529E01
10. CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL (See page CH-7)
HB
11. INSTALL REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
12. INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-8)
13. INSTALL REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
14. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
HORN – HORN SYSTEM
HO–1
HORN SYSTEM
BODY ELECTRICAL
HORN
PARTS LOCATION
STEERING PAD SWITCH
HO
LOW PITCHED HORN
HIGH PITCHED HORN
ENGINE ROOM JUNCTION BLOCK, RELAY BLOCK
- INTEGRATION RELAY (UNIT B: HORN RELAY)
- HORN FUSE
- BATT P/I H-FUSE
B127759E01
HO–2
HORN – HORN SYSTEM
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
HORN
BATT P/I
Integration Relay (Unit B)
HORN
MAIN
HO
Steering Pad
Switch
Low
Pitched
Horn
High
Pitched
Horn
B136931E01
HO–3
HORN – HORN SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
Use the table below to help determine the cause of the
problem symptom. The potential causes of the symptoms are
listed in order of probability in the "Suspected area" column of
the table. Check each symptom by checking the suspected
areas in the order they are listed. Replace parts as
necessary.
Horn system
Symptom
Horn does not sound
Suspected area
See page
1. HORN fuse
HO-1
2. HORN relay
HO-4
3. High pitched horn
HO-8
4. Low pitched horn
HO-6
5. Steering pad switch
-
6. Spiral cable
-
HO
HO–4
HORN – INTEGRATION RELAY
INTEGRATION RELAY
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
INSPECT FUSE (HORN)
(a) Measure the resistance of the fuse.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the fuse.
3.
INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY (HORN RELAY)
(a) Using a screwdriver, detach the 2 claws and
disconnect the integration relay from the engine
room No. 1 junction block.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Disconnect the 3 connectors from the integration
relay.
(c) Measure the resistance of the HORN relay.
Standard voltage
HO
Tester Connection
3K
1
3K
3J
1
8 765 4 321
Specified Condition
3J-8 - 3K-1
10 kΩ or higher
3J-8 - 3K-1
Below 1 Ω (when battery voltage is
applied to terminals 3J-7 and 3K-1)
If the result is not as specified, replace the
integration relay.
(d) Connect the 3 connectors to the integration relay.
(e) Install the integration relay to the engine room No. 1
junction block.
4.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
5.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization ( IN-32).
CAUTION:
Certain system need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
3J
8
7
B136930E01
HO–5
HORN – LOW PITCHED HORN
LOW PITCHED HORN
BODY ELECTRICAL
HORN
COMPONENTS
20 (204, 15)
LOW PITCHED HORN
HO
FRONT BUMPER COVER
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B127784E01
HO–6
HORN – LOW PITCHED HORN
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE FRONT BUMPER COVER (See page ET-4)
2.
REMOVE LOW PITCHED HORN
(a) Disconnect the horn connector.
(b) Remove the bolt and horn.
B127786E01
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT LOW PITCHED HORN
(a) Apply battery voltage to the horn and check the
operation of the horn.
OK
Measurement Condition
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 1
Horn sounds
Battery negative (-) → Horn bracket
B072268E02
If the result is not as specified, replace the horn.
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL LOW PITCHED HORN
(a) Place the stay onto the baffle part of the radiator
support upper, and then install the horn with the
bolt.
Torque: 20 N*m (204 kgf*cm, 15 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Do not overlap the horn and the protruding part
of the radiator support.
(b) Connect the horn connector.
2.
INSTALL FRONT BUMPER COVER (See page ET-6)
HO
B127786E01
HORN – HIGH PITCHED HORN
HO–7
HIGH PITCHED HORN
BODY ELECTRICAL
HORN
COMPONENTS
HIGH PITCHED HORN
HO
20 (204, 15)
FRONT BUMPER COVER
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B127785E01
HO–8
HORN – HIGH PITCHED HORN
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE FRONT BUMPER COVER (See page ET-4)
2.
REMOVE HIGH PITCHED HORN
(a) Disconnect the horn connector.
(b) Remove the bolt and horn.
B127787E01
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT HIGH PITCHED HORN
(a) Apply battery voltage to the horn and check the
operation of the horn.
OK
Measurement Condition
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 1
Horn sounds
Battery negative (-) → Horn bracket
B072265E05
If the result is not as specified, replace the horn.
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL HIGH PITCHED HORN
(a) Place the stay onto the baffle part of the radiator
support upper, and then install the horn with the
bolt.
Torque: 20 N*m (204 kgf*cm, 15 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Do not overlap the horn and the protruding part
of the radiator support.
(b) Connect the horn connector.
2.
INSTALL FRONT BUMPER COVER (See page ET-6)
HO
B127787E01
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–1
HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
1.
Lever
A083545E01
PRECAUTIONS FOR INSPECTING THE HYBRID
CONTROL SYSTEM
(a) Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take
safety precautions to prevent electrical shocks, such
as wearing insulated gloves and removing the
service plug grip (see page IN-5). After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent
other technicians from reconnecting it while you are
servicing the high-voltage system.
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause a
malfunction. Therefore, do not turn the power
switch ON (READY) unless instructed by the
repair manual.
(b) After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at
least 5 minutes before touching any of high-voltage
connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the
high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
(c) Since liquid leakage may occur, wear protective
goggles when checking inside the HV battery.
(d) Wear insulated gloves, turn the power switch OFF,
and disconnect the negative terminal of the auxiliary
battery before touching any of the orange-colored
wires of the high-voltage system.
(e) Turn the power switch OFF before performing a
resistance check.
(f) Turn the power switch OFF before disconnecting or
reconnecting any connector.
HV
HV–2
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
(g) To install the service plug grip, the lever must be
flipped and locked downward. Once it is locked in
place, it turns the interlock switch ON. Make sure to
lock it securely because if you leave it unlocked, the
system will output a DTC pertaining to the interlock
switch system.
Lever
Lock
A089219E01
2.
HV
NOTICE FOR INITIALIZATION
When disconnecting the cable from the negative (-)
battery terminal, initialize the following systems after the
cable is reconnected.
System Name
See Procedure
Power Window Control System
IN-32
3.
NOTICE FOR HYBRID SYSTEM ACTIVATION
• When the warning light is illuminated or the battery
has been disconnected and reconnected, pressing
the power switch may not start the system on the first
attempt. If so, press the power switch again.
• With the power switch's power mode changed to ON
(IG), disconnect the battery. If the key is not in the key
slot during reconnection, DTC B2799 may be output.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–3
DEFINITION OF TERMS
1. DEFINITION OF TERMS
Each monitor description follows a standardized format using
these terms:
Terms
Definition
Duration
The minimum time that the HV control ECU must sense a continuous
deviation in the monitored value(s) before setting a DTC. This timing
begins after the "typical enabling conditions" are met.
Frequency of operation
The number of times that the HV control ECU checks for malfunction
per driving cycle.
"Once per driving cycle" means that the HV control ECU detects
malfunction only one time during a single driving cycle.
"Continuous" means that the HV control ECU detects malfunction
every time when enabling condition is met.
MIL operation
MIL illumination timing after a defect is detected.
"Immediately" means that the HV control ECU illuminates the MIL the
instant the HV control ECU determines that there is malfunction.
"2 driving cycles" means that the HV control ECU illuminates the MIL if
the same malfunction is detected again in the 2nd driving cycle.
Monitor description
Description of what the HV control ECU monitors and how it detects
malfunction (monitoring purpose and its details).
Related DTCs
A group of DTCs that is classified by a system and a troubleshooting
procedure.
Required sensor / components
The sensors and components that are used by the HV control ECU to
detect malfunction.
Sequence of operation
The priority order that is applied to monitoring, if multiple sensors and
components are used to detect the malfunction.
While another sensor is being monitored, the next sensor or
component will not be monitored until the previous monitoring has
concluded.
Typical enabling condition
Preconditions that allow the HV control ECU to detect malfunction.
With all preconditions satisfied, the HV control ECU sets the DTC
when the monitored value(s) exceeds the malfunction threshold(s).
Typical malfunction thresholds
Beyond this value, the HV control ECU will conclude that there is
malfunction and set a DTC.
HV
HV–4
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
ELECTRIC INVERTER COMPRESSOR
(W/ MOTOR COMPRESSOR ASSEMBLY)
INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK
ASSEMBLY
AUXILIARY
BATTERY
HV BATTERY
HV
FRAME WIRE
ENGINE ROOM RELAY BLOCK
COOLING FAN
MOTOR
- INTEGRATION RELAY
- HEV FUSE
NO. 2 COOLING FAN
MOTOR
WATER PUMP WITH MOTOR ASSEMBLY
HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
A125398E01
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–5
RESERVOIR TANK
INVERTER COVER
NO. 1 CIRCUIT
BREAKER SENSOR
HYBRID VEHICLE GENERATOR
(NO. 1 MOTOR GENERATOR
[MG1])
HYBRID VEHICLE MOTOR
(NO. 2 MOTOR GENERATOR
[MG2])
HV
GENERATOR RESOLVER
MOTOR RESOLVER
NO. 1 MOTOR TEMPERATURE SENSOR AND
NO. 2 MOTOR TEMPERATURE SENSOR
A125399E01
HV–6
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
NO. 2 FRAME WIRE
JUNCTION BLOCK
BATTERY ECU
BATTERY
PLUG
MAIN BATTERY CABLE
HV
SERVICE PLUG
GRIP
NO. 2 MAIN BATTERY CABLE
SYSTEM MAIN
RELAY
NO. 3 SYSTEM MAIN
RELAY
NO. 2 SYSTEM MAIN
RELAY
SYSTEM MAIN RESISTOR
A125400E01
HV–7
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
COMBINATION METER
TRANSPONDER KEY ECU
POWER SWITCH
GATEWAY ECU
MULTI-DISPLAY
ECM
ENTRY KEY ECU
POWER SOURCE
CONTROL ECU
HYBRID VEHICLE
CONTROL ECU
P POSITION SWITCH
TRANSMISSION CONTROL
ECU ASSEMBLY
SELECTOR LEVER
DRIVER SIDE
JUNCTION BLOCK
DLC3
HV
AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
- BODY ECU
CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
SKID CONTROL ECU
ACCELERATOR PEDAL ROD
POWER STEERING ECU
A125401E01
HV–8
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
Hybrid Vehicle Control ECU
BATT
IG2
HEV
IGCT
AM2
+B1
+B2
IGN
MREL
Power Source
Control ECU
IGSW
IG2D
P/I
AM2
IG1D
AM1
STSW
AM1
HV
DC / DC
ST2
Stop Light Switch
ST1-
STOP
STP
MAIN
Water Pump
Water Pump
IG1
A/C (HTR)
M
Auxiliary
Battery
WP
A133108E01
HV–9
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
P Position Switch
P1
Cruise Control Main Switch
Spiral Cable
CCS
ECM
NEO
NEO
GO
GO
CAN Communication
CANH
HV
CANL
Selector Lever
VCX1
VCX1
VSX1
VSX1
E2X1
E2X1
VCX2
VCX2
VSX2
VSX2
E2X2
E2X2
VCX3
VCX3
VSX3
VSX3
VCX4
VCX4
VSX4
VSX4
A125636E01
HV–10
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Accelerator Pedal Rod
VCPA
VCP1
VPA
VPA1
EPA
EP1
VCP2
VCP2
VPA2
VPA2
EP2
EP2
Transmission Control ECU Assembly
PCON
PCON
PPOS
PPOS
P
RDY
RDY
Power Source Control ECU
Transponder Key ECU
HV
HEV1
IMI
HEV0
IMO
Center Airbag Sensor
GSW2
ABFS
DLC3
TC
TC
Combination Meter
SPDI
A126762E01
HV–11
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Inverter with Converter Assembly
DC / DC
Converter
VLO
VLO
NODD
A/C
Inverter
NODD
STB
STB
TOINV
ETI
TOECU
ITE
CLK
Boost
Converter
CLK
VL
VL
CPWM
CPWM
CSDN
CSDN
CT
CT
GCNV
GCNV
(+)
Generator
Inverter
OVL
OVL
FCV
FCV
GSDN
GSDN
GIVT
GIVT
GUU
GUU
GVU
GVU
GWU
GWU
GIVA
GIVA
GIVB
GIVB
GIWA
GIWA
GIWB
GIWB
GFIV
GFIV
HV
No. 1 Motor Generator (MG1)
G-U
GRF
GRFG
(-)
G-V
GSN
GSNG
G-W
GCS
GCSG
GRF
GRFG
GSN
GSNG
GCS
GCSG
A125638E01
HV–12
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
MIVT
MIVT
MSDN
MSDN
GINV
GINV
MUU
MUU
MVU
MVU
MWU
MWU
MIVA
MIVA
MIVB
MIVB
MIWA
MIWA
MIWB
MIWB
VH
VH
MFIV
MFIV
OVH
OVH
Motor Inverter
HV
No. 2 Motor Generator (MG2)
M-U
MRF
MRFG
M-V
MSN
MSNG
M-W
MCS
MCSG
MMT
MMTG
OMT
OMTG
MRF
MRFG
MSN
MSNG
MCS
MCSG
MMT
MMTG
OMT
OMTG
A125639E01
HV–13
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Interlock
Switch
No. 1 Circuit Breaker Sensor
SFI+
AS1
SFI-
AS1G
ILK
HV Battery Assembly
No. 2 System Main Relay
Inverter with
Converter
Interlock Switch
(+)
CON2
System Main
Resistor
HV
CON1
Service Plug Grip
No. 1 System Main Relay
Inverter with
Converter
(-)
CON3
No. 3 System Main Relay
GND1
GND2
A125640E01
HV–14
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Communication Diagram:
ECM
Battery ECU
Power Steering
ECU
HV Control ECU
Skid Control
ECU
Gateway ECU
Multi Display
HV
: CAN
: BEAN
Body ECU
Air Conditioning
Amplifier
Transponder
Key ECU
Combination
Meter
Power Source
Control ECU
Entry Key ECU
: AVC-LAN
A093744E01
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–15
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
GENERAL
The THS-II control system consists of the following
controls.
Item
Outline
HV Control ECU Control
•
•
•
•
•
The HV control ECU controls the MG1, MG2, engine, regenerative
brake control and HV battery SOC. These factors are determined
by the shift position, accelerator pedal position and vehicle speed.
The HV control ECU monitors the SOC and temperature of the HV
battery, MG1 and MG2, in order to optimally control these items.
When the shift position is in N, the HV control ECU effects
shutdown control to electrically stop the MG1 and MG2.
If there is no traction at the drive wheels, the HV control ECU
performs a motor traction control function which restrains the
rotation of MG2, in order to protect the planetary gear unit and
prevent MG1 from generating excessive electricity.
To protect the circuit from high voltage and to ensure circuit
shutdown reliability, the HV control ECU effects SMR control using
3 relays to connect and shut down the high-voltage circuit.
ECM Control
The ECM receives the demand power value and the target rpm, which
were sent from the HV control ECU, and controls the ETCS-i system,
fuel injection volume, ignition timing and VVT-i system.
Inverter Control
•
•
•
Boost Converter Control
•
•
Converter Control
•
•
In accordance with the signals provided by the HV control ECU,
the inverter converts a direct current (HV battery) into an
alternating current (MG1 and MG2), or vice versa. In addition, the
inverter supplies the AC (MG1) power to the AC (MG2). However,
when electricity is supplied from MG1 to MG2, the electricity is
converted into DC inside the inverter.
The HV control ECU sends the signal to the power transistor in
the inverter for switching the U, V and W phase of the MG1 and
MG2 in order to drive the MG1 and MG2.
The HV control ECU shuts down if it receives an overheating, over
current, or fault voltage signal from the inverter.
In accordance with the signals provided by the HV control ECU,
the boost converter boosts the nominal voltage of DC 201.6 V (for
HV battery) up to the maximum voltage of DC 500 V.
The maximum voltage of AC 500 V generated by the MG1 or MG2
is converted into a direct current by the inverter, the boost
converter reduces the direct current to DC 201.6 V (for HV
battery) based on the signals from the HV control ECU.
The DC / DC converter reduces the nominal voltage of DC 201.6
V to DC 12 V in order to supply electricity to body electrical
components, as well as to recharge the auxiliary battery (DC 12
V).
This converter maintains a constant voltage at the terminals of the
auxiliary battery.
A/C Inverter Control
A/C inverter converts the nominal voltage of the HV battery from DC
201.6 to AC 201.6 V and supplies power to operate the electric
compressor of the A/C system.
MG1 and MG2 Main Control
•
•
•
•
MG1, which is rotated by the engine, generates high voltage
(maximum voltage of AC 500 V) in order to operate the MG2 and
charge the HV battery. Also, it functions as a starter to start the
engine.
MG2 primarily provides additional power to the engine in order to
increase the overall drive force. During braking, or when the
accelerator pedal is not depressed, it generates electricity to
recharge the HV battery (regenerative brake system).
Speed sensors detect the speed and position of the MG1 and
MG2 and output them to the HV control ECU.
A temperature sensor mounted on the MG2 detects a MG2
temperature and transmits it to the HV control ECU.
HV
HV–16
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Item
Outline
Skid Control ECU Control
During braking, the skid control ECU calculates the total braking force
and transmits a regenerative brake force request to the HV control
ECU. Upon receiving this signal, the HV control ECU calculates the
magnitude of regeneration brake force required and transmits it to the
skid control ECU. Based on this, the skid control ECU calculates and
executes the required hydraulic pressure brake force.
Battery ECU Control
The battery ECU monitors the condition of the HV battery and controls
the cooling fan to keep the HV battery at a predetermined
temperature. Thus, it optimally controls these components.
Shift Control
•
•
The HV control ECU detects the shift position (P, R, N, D, or B) in
accordance with the signal provided by the shift position sensor,
and controls the MG1, MG2, and engine, in order to create the
driving conditions that suit the selected shift position.
The transmission control ECU assembly detects that the driver
has pressed the P position switch through a signal provided by the
HV control ECU. The transmission control ECU assembly then
operates the shift control actuator in order to mechanically lock
the transaxle.
During Collision Control
At the time of a collision, if the HV control ECU receives an airbag
deployment signal from the center airbag sensor or an actuation
signal from the circuit breaker sensor located in the inverter, it turns
OFF the SMR and power switch in order to shut off the entire power
supply.
Cruise Control System Operation Control
When the cruise control ECU built into the HV control ECU receives a
cruise control switch signal, it calculates the cruise control request
value, and calculates the motive forces of the engine, MG1, and MG2
to achieve an optimal combination.
Indicator and Warning Light Illumination Control
Illuminates or blinks the lights to inform the driver of the vehicle
condition or a system malfunction.
Diagnosis
When the HV control ECU detects a malfunction, the HV control ECU
diagnoses and stores values corresponding to the failure.
Fail-safe
When the HV control ECU detects a malfunction, the HV control ECU
stops or controls the actuator and ECUs according to the data already
stored in its memory.
HV
2.
Inverter
Planetary
Gear
MG1
HV
Battery
Engine
MG2
Wheel
A125406E01
BASIC OPERATION
(a) This system controls the following modes in order to
achieve the most efficient operations to match the
driving conditions:
(1) Supply of electrical power from the HV battery to
MG2 provides force to drive the wheels.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
(2) While the wheels are being driven by the engine
via the planetary gear, MG1 is rotated by the engine
via the planetary gears, in order to supply the
generated electricity to MG2.
Inverter
Planetary
Gear
HV–17
MG1
HV
Battery
Engine
MG2
Wheel
A125407E01
(3) MG1 is rotated by the engine via the planetary
gear, in order to charge the HV battery.
Inverter
Planetary
Gear
MG1
HV
Battery
Engine
MG2
Wheel
HV
A125408E01
Inverter
Planetary
Gear
MG1
HV
Battery
Engine
MG2
Wheel
A125409E01
(4) When the vehicle is decelerating, kinetic energy
from the wheels is recovered and converted into
electrical energy and used to recharge the HV
battery by means of MG2.
(b) The HV control ECU switches between these
modes ((1), (2), (3), (1) + (2) + (3), or (4)) according
to the driving condition. However, when the SOC
(State of Charge) of the HV battery is low, the HV
battery is charged by the engine by turning MG1.
As a result, it achieves far greater fuel economy
compared to conventional gasoline engine vehicles,
at a reduced level of exhaust gas emissions.
Furthermore, this revolutionary powertrain has
eliminated the constraints that are associated with
electric vehicles (such as their short cruising range
or their reliance on external recharging units).
HV–18
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
3.
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
Shift Position Sensor
Inverter Assembly
Accelerator Pedal Position
Sensor
Inverter
A/C
Inverter
Engine Condition
Electric
Inverter
Compressor
(for A/C)
Boost
Converter
ECM
Engine Control
- Speed Sensor
- Yaw Rate and
Deceleration
Rate Sensor*
- Steering
Angle Sensor*
- Brake Pedal
Stroke Sensor
Skid Control
ECU
DC / DC
Converter
HV
Control
ECU
*1
*2
Resistor
SMR1
SMR2
SMR3
Auxiliary
Battery
Brake
Actuator
HV
MG1
MG2
Engine
: CAN
Current Sensor
Battery
ECU
HV Battery
To Rear Wheel
: Mechanical Power Path
: Hydraulic Power Path
: Electrical Signal
*1: Regenerative Brake Force Request
*2: Actual Regenerative Braking Control Valve
: Only on model with Enhanced VSC system
A126252E01
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
4.
HV–19
FUNCTION OF MAIN COMPONENTS
Item
Outline
MG1
MG1, which is rotated by the engine, generates high-voltage electricity
in order to operate the MG2 or charge the HV battery. Also, it functions
as a starter to start the engine.
MG2
•
•
Driven by electrical power from the MG1 or HV battery, and
generates motive force for the vehicle.
During braking, or when the accelerator pedal is not depressed, it
generates electricity to recharge the HV battery (regenerative
brake control).
Planetary Gear Unit
Distributes the engine's drive force as appropriate to directly drive the
vehicle as well as the generator.
HV Battery
Supplies electric power to the MG2 during start-off, acceleration, and
uphill driving. Recharged during braking or when the accelerator pedal
is not depressed.
Inverter
Converts the high-voltage DC (HV battery) into AC (MG1 and MG2)
and vice versa (converts AC into DC).
Boost Converter
Boosts the nominal voltage of the HV battery from DC 201.6 to DC
500 V and vice versa (reduces voltage from DC 500 V to DC 201.6 V).
DC / DC Converter
Reduces the nominal voltage of DC 201.6 V to DC 12 V in order to
supply electricity to body electrical components, as well as to recharge
the auxiliary battery (DC 12 V).
A/C Inverter
Converts the nominal voltage of DC 201.6 V of the HV battery to AC
201.6 V and supplies power to operate the electric inverter
compressor of the A/C system.
HV Control ECU
Receives information from each sensor as well as from the ECUs
(ECM, battery ECU, skid control ECU, and EPS ECU), and based on
this information, required torque and output power are calculated.
Sends the calculated result to the ECM, inverter assembly, battery
ECU and skid control ECU.
ECM
Activates the ETCS-i (Electronic Throttle Control System-intelligent) in
accordance with the target engine speed and required engine motive
force received from the HV control ECU.
Battery ECU
Monitors the charging condition of the HV battery.
Skid Control ECU
Controls the regenerative brake that is effected by the MG2 and the
hydraulic brake so that the total braking force equals that of a
conventional vehicle that is equipped only with hydraulic brakes.
Also, performs the brake system control (ABS with EBD, Brake Assist,
and Enhanced VSC*) conventionally.
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor
Converts the accelerator pedal position angle into an electrical signal
and outputs it to the HV control ECU.
Shift Position Sensor
Converts the shift position into an electrical signal and outputs it to the
HV control ECU.
SMR (System Main Relay)
Connects and disconnects the high-voltage power circuit between the
battery and the inverter assembly, using a signal from the HV control
ECU.
Interlock Switch
(for Inverter Cover and Service Plug Grip)
Verifies that the cover of both the inverter and the service plug grip
have been installed.
Circuit Breaker Sensor
The high-voltage circuit is interrupted if a vehicle collision has been
detected.
Service Plug Grip
Shuts off the high-voltage circuit of the HV battery when this plug is
removed for vehicle inspection or maintenance.
HINT:
*: Only on model with Enhanced VSC System
HV
HV–20
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
*: Use the intelligent tester.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS
NEXT
3
CONNECT INTELLIGENT TESTER TO DLC3*
HINT:
If the display indicates a communication fault in the tester,
inspect the DLC3.
NEXT
4
CHECK AND RECORD DTC AND FREEZE FRAME DATA*
HINT:
If a DTC related to the CAN communication system
malfunction is output, first troubleshoot and repair the CAN
communication (see page CA-6).
HV
NEXT
5
CLEAR DTC*
NEXT
6
PROBLEM SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION
(a) When the malfunction does not occur, go to A.
(b) When the malfunction occurs, go to B.
B
A
7
NEXT
SYMPTOM SIMULATION
Go to step 8
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
8
HV–21
CHECK DTC*
NEXT
9
DTC CHART
NEXT
10
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
NEXT
11
IDENTIFICATION OF PROBLEM
NEXT
12
ADJUSTMENT AND / OR REPAIR
NEXT
13
NEXT
END
CONFIRMATION TEST
HV
HV–22
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT
PROBLEMS
1.
HV
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
(a) Perform a simulation test (see page IN-36).
(1) In the simulation test, reproduce the driving
condition at the trouble occurrence according to
the customer's comments and freeze frame data
recorded with DTCs, such as an opening angle
of the accelerator pedal, SOC, engine coolant
temperature, engine rpm, and MG1/MG2 rpm
and torque.
(b) Check the connector(s) and terminal(s) (see
pageIN-45).
(c) Wiggle the harness and connector(s) (see page IN45).
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–23
REGISTRATION
NOTICE:
The Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) must be input
into the replacement HV control ECU.
HINT:
The VIN is a 17-digit alphanumeric vehicle identification
number. The intelligent tester is required to register the VIN.
1.
2.
INPUT INSTRUCTIONS
(a) Explains the general VIN input instructions using the
intelligent tester.
(b) Intelligent Tester
The arrow buttons (UP, DOWN, RIGHT and LEFT)
and numerical buttons (0 to 9) are used to input the
VIN.
(c) Cursor Operation
To move the cursor around the tester screen, press
the RIGHT and LEFT buttons.
(d) Alphabetical Character Input
(1) Press the UP and DOWN buttons to select the
desired alphabetical character.
(2) After selection, the cursor should move.
(e) Numeric Character Input
(1) Press the numerical button corresponding to
the number that you want to input.
(2) Select or input the correct character using the
UP/DOWN buttons, or the numerical buttons.
HINT:
Numerical characters can be selected by using
the UP and DOWN buttons.
(f) Correction
(1) After input, the cursor should move.
(2) When correcting the input character(s), put the
cursor onto the character using the RIGHT or
LEFT buttons.
(g) Finishing Input Operation
(1) Make sure that the input VIN matches the
vehicle VIN after input.
(2) Press the ENTER button on the tester.
READ VIN (Vehicle Identification Number)
(a) Explains the VIN reading process in a flowchart.
Reading the VIN stored in the HV control ECU is
necessary when comparing it to the VIN provided
with the vehicle.
(b) Read VIN using the intelligent tester.
(c) Check the vehicle's VIN.
(d) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(e) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(f) Turn the tester ON.
HV
HV–24
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
(g) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD ll / VIN.
Menu Screen:
Select VIN READ
VIN Previously Stored
DTC P0630 Set
VIN Not Stored
17-digit VIN
displayed
HV
[EXIT]
[EXIT]
[EXIT]
To Menu Screen
A103812E03
3.
WRITE VIN
(a) Explains the VIN writing process in a flowchart.
This process allows the VIN to be input into the HV
control ECU. If the HV control ECU is changed, or
the HV control ECU VIN and Vehicle VIN do not
match, the VIN can be registered, or overwritten in
the HV control ECU by following this procedure.
(b) Write VIN using the intelligent tester.
(c) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(e) Turn the tester ON.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
(f)
HV–25
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS /
ENHANCED OBD ll / VIN.
Menu Screen:
Select VIN WRITE
VIN Previously Stored
[NO]
[YES]
[YES]
[YES]
To Menu
Screen
17-digit VIN displayed
[NO]
Continue to next illustration
To Menu Screen
A103813E01
HV
HV–26
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
New Registration
[ENTER]
Input Instructions
[ENTER]
[ENTER]
[ENTER]
Input Error
HV
[EXIT]
Continue to next illustration
A103814E03
HV–27
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Writing Successful
Writing Error
Communication Error
[ENTER]
[EXIT]
[EXIT]
To Menu Screen
To Menu Screen
To Menu Screen
A103815E03
HV
HV–28
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
TERMINALS OF ECU
H17
H16
H15
H14
A066714E30
HV
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
STD Voltage (V)
ST2 (H14-5) - GND1
(H14-1)
Y - W-B
Starter signal
Power switch ON
(READY)
9 to 14
IGSW (H14-7) - GND1
(H14-1)
O - W-B
IG signal
Power switch ON (IG)
9 to 14
BATT (H15-6) - GND1
(H14-1)
Y - W-B
Auxiliary battery (for
measuring the battery
voltage and for the HV
control ECU memory)
Always
9 to 14
+B1 (H16-7) - GND1
(H14-1)
L - W-B
Power source of HV
control ECU
Power switch ON (IG)
9 to 14
+B2 (H16-6) - GND1
(H14-1)
L - W-B
Power source of HV
control ECU
Power switch ON (IG)
9 to 14
MREL (H16-4) - GND1
(H14-1)
O - W-B
Main relay
Power switch ON (IG)
9 to 14
CANH (H14-8) - GND1
(H14-1)
B - W-B
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Power switch ON (IG)
Pulse generation
(see waveform 1)
CANL (H14-9) - GND1
(H14-1)
W - W-B
LOW-level CAN bus line
Power switch ON (IG)
Pulse generation
(see waveform 2)
NEO (H16-12) - GND1
(H14-1)
LG - W-B
Engine speed signal
Engine running
Pulse generation
(see waveform 3)
GO (H16-13) - GND1
(H14-1)
Y - W-B
G signal
Engine running
Pulse generation
(see waveform 4)
SPDI (H14-19) - GND1
(H14-1)
V - W-B
Vehicle speed signal
Driving at approximately
12 mph (20 km/h)
Pulse generation
(see waveform 5)
VPA1 (H16-26) - EP1
(H16-27)
L-B
Accelerator pedal position Power switch ON (IG),
sensor (for the HV system) accelerator pedal released
0.5 to 1.1
VPA1 (H16-26) - EP1
(H16-27)
L-B
Accelerator pedal position
sensor (for the HV system)
Power switch ON (IG),
engine stopped in P
position, accelerator pedal
fully depressed
2.6 to 4.5
VPA2 (H16-34) - EP2
(H16-35)
W-R
Accelerator pedal position
sensor (for the sensor
malfunction detection)
Power switch ON (IG),
accelerator pedal fully
depressed
1.2 to 2.0
VPA2 (H16-34) - EP2
(H16-35)
W-R
Accelerator pedal position
sensor (for the sensor
malfunction detection)
Power switch ON (IG),
engine stopped in P
position, accelerator pedal
released
3.4 to 5.3
VCP1 (H16-25) - EP1
(H16-27)
Y-B
Power source of
accelerator pedal position
sensor (for VPA1)
Power switch ON (IG)
4.5 to 5.5
HV–29
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
STD Voltage (V)
VCP2 (H16-33) - EP2
(H16-35)
G-R
Power source of
accelerator pedal position
sensor (for VPA2)
Power switch ON (IG)
4.5 to 5.5
VSX1 (H14-25) - E2X1
(H14-15)
B-R
Shift position sensor
(main)
Power switch ON (IG),
selector lever home
position
2.0 to 3.0
VSX1 (H14-25) - E2X1
(H14-15)
B-R
Shift position sensor
(main)
Power switch ON (IG),
selector lever moved to R
position
4.0 to 4.8
VSX1 (H14-25) - E2X1
(H14-15)
B-R
Shift position sensor
(main)
Power switch ON (IG),
selector lever moved to B
or D position
0.2 to 1.0
VSX2 (H14-24) - E2X2
(H14-14)
L-Y
Shift position sensor (sub)
Power switch ON (IG),
selector lever home
position
2.0 to 3.0
VSX2 (H14-24) - E2X2
(H14-14)
L-Y
Shift position sensor (sub)
Power switch ON (IG),
selector lever moved to R
position
4.0 to 4.8
VSX2 (H14-24) - E2X2
(H14-14)
L-Y
Shift position sensor (sub)
Power switch ON (IG),
selector lever moved to B
or D position
0.2 to 1.0
VCX1 (H14-17) - E2X1
(H14-15)
W-R
Power source of shift
position sensor (for VSX1)
Power switch ON (IG)
4.5 to 5.5
VCX2 (H14-16) - E2X2
(H14-14)
G-Y
Power source of shift
position sensor (for VSX2)
Power switch ON (IG)
4.5 to 5.5
VSX3 (H14-23) - GND1
(H14-1)
BR - W-B
Select position sensor
(main)
Power switch ON (IG),
selector lever home
position
0.5 to 2.0
VSX3 (H14-23) - GND1
(H14-1)
BR - W-B
Select position sensor
(main)
Power switch ON (IG),
selector lever moved to R,
N or D position
3.0 to 4.85
VSX4 (H14-30) - GND1
(H14-1)
SB - W-B
Select position sensor
(sub)
Power switch ON (IG),
selector lever home
position
0.5 to 2.0
VSX4 (H14-30) - GND1
(H14-1)
SB- W-B
Select position sensor
(sub)
Power switch ON (IG),
selector lever moved to R,
N or D position
3.0 to 4.85
VCX3 (H14-21) - GND1
(H14-1)
W - W-B
Power source of select
position sensor (for VSX3)
Power switch ON (IG)
9 to 14
VCX4 (H14-31) - GND1
(H14-1)
P - W-B
Power source of select
position sensor (for VSX4)
Power switch ON (IG)
9 to 14
NODD (H16-24) - GND1
(H14-1)
V - W-B
DC / DC movement
monitor or stop request
signal
When converter is in
normal operation
5 to 7
NODD (H16-24) - GND1
(H14-1)
V - W-B
DC / DC movement
monitor or stop request
signal
When converter is
improper
2 to 4
NODD (H16-24) - GND1
(H14-1)
V - W-B
DC / DC movement
monitor or stop request
signal
When converter is
required to stop
0.1 to 0.5
VLO (H16-31) - GND1
(H14-1)
L - W-B
Two-stage selector signal
Converter switching to 14
V output
13 to 14
VLO (H16-31) - GND1
(H14-1)
L - W-B
Two-stage selector signal
Converter switching to
13.5 V output
Below 0.5
TC (H14-6) - GND1 (H141)
P - W-B
Terminal TC of DLC3
Power switch ON (IG)
9 to 14
STP (H15-3) - GND1
(H14-1)
L - W-B
Stop light switch
Brake pedal depressed
9 to 14
STP (H15-3) - GND1
(H14-1)
L - W-B
Stop light switch
Brake pedal released
2 to 3
HV
HV–30
HV
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
STD Voltage (V)
ABFS (H14-20) - GND1
(H14-1)
L - W-B
Airbag deployment signal
Power switch ON
(READY) (2 seconds after
ON [ACC] )
Pulse generation
(see waveform 6, 7, 8)
AS1 (H16-15) - AS1G
(H16-16)
Y-W
No. 1 circuit breaker
sensor
Satellite signal system
normal
2.5 to 2.9
ILK (H15-1) - GND1 (H141)
V - W-B
Interlock switch
Power switch ON (IG),
inverter cover and service
plug grip installed normally
Below 1
ILK (H15-1) - GND1 (H141)
V - W-B
Interlock switch
Power switch ON (IG),
inverter cover or service
plug grip detached
9 to 14
CON1 (H16-1) - GND1
(H14-1)
R - W-B
No. 1 system main relay
Power switch OFF to ON
(READY)
Pulse generation
(see waveform 9)
CON2 (H16-2) - GND1
(H14-1)
G - W-B
No. 2 system main relay
Power switch OFF to ON
(READY)
Pulse generation
(see waveform 9)
CON3 (H16-3) - GND1
(H14-1)
Y - W-B
No. 3 system main relay
Power switch OFF to ON
(READY)
Pulse generation
(see waveform 9)
VH (H15-26) - GINV (H1523)
Y - W-B
Inverter condenser voltage
monitor
Power switch ON
(READY)
1.6 to 3.8
GUU (H15-15) - GINV
(H15-23)
B-Y
Generator switch U signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Pulse generation
(see waveform 10)
GVU (H15-14) - GINV
(H15-23)
G-Y
Generator switch V signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Pulse generation
(see waveform 10)
GWU (H15-13) - GINV
(H15-23)
Y-Y
Generator switch W signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Pulse generation
(see waveform 10)
GIVA (H15-34) - GINV
(H15-23)
W-Y
Generator V phase current
Power switch ON (IG)
Approximately 0
GIVB (H15-33) - GINV
(H15-23)
B-Y
Generator V phase current
Power switch ON (IG)
Approximately 0
GIWA (H15-32) - GINV
(H15-23)
R-Y
Generator W phase
current
Power switch ON (IG)
Approximately 0
GIWB (H15-31) - GINV
(H15-23)
G-Y
Generator W phase
current
Power switch ON (IG)
Approximately 0
GIVT (H15-27) - GINV
(H15-23)
W-Y
Generator inverter
temperature sensor
Power switch ON (IG)
2 to 4.5
GSDN (H15-16) - GINV
(H15-23)
R - W-B
Generator shutdown
signal
Power switch ON
(READY), N position
0.2 to 0.7
GSDN (H15-16) - GINV
(H15-23)
R - W-B
Generator shutdown
signal
Power switch ON
(READY), P position
5.1 to 13.6
GFIV (H15-35) - GINV
(H15-23)
GR - W-B
Generator inverter fail
signal
Power switch ON (IG),
inverter normal
5.4 to 7.4
GFIV (H15-35) - GINV
(H15-23)
GR - W-B
Generator inverter fail
signal
Power switch ON (IG),
inverter abnormal
2 to 3
GRF (H17-27) - GRFG
(H17-26)
B-W
Generator resolver signal
Generator resolver
stopped or rotating
Pulse generation
(see waveform 11, 12)
GSN (H17-22) - GSNG
(H17-21)
R-G
Generator resolver signal
Generator resolver
stopped or rotating
Pulse generation
(see waveform 11, 12)
GCS (H17-23) - GCSG
(H17-24)
Y - BR
Generator resolver signal
Generator resolver
stopped or rotating
Pulse generation
(see waveform 11, 12)
OMT (H17-30) - OMTG
(H17-29)
B-G
No. 2 motor temperature
sensor
Refer to DATA LIST (see
page HV-49)
-
MUU (H15-9) - GINV
(H15-23)
B-Y
Motor switch U signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Pulse generation
(see waveform 13)
MVU (H15-10) - GINV
(H15-23)
W-Y
Motor switch V signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Pulse generation
(see waveform 13)
MWU (H15-11) - GINV
(H15-23)
R-Y
Motor switch W signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Pulse generation
(see waveform 13)
HV–31
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
STD Voltage (V)
MIVA (H15-30) - GINV
(H15-23)
G-Y
Motor V phase current
Power switch ON (IG)
Approximately 0
MIVB (H15-21) - GINV
(H15-23)
W-Y
Motor V phase current
Power switch ON (IG)
Approximately 0
MIWA (H15-29) - GINV
(H15-23)
R-Y
Motor W phase current
Power switch ON (IG)
Approximately 0
MIWB (H15-20) - GINV
(H15-23)
B-Y
Motor W phase current
Power switch ON (IG)
Approximately 0
MIVT (H15-19) - GINV
(H15-23)
L-Y
Motor inverter temperature
sensor
Power switch ON (IG)
2 to 4.5
MSDN (H15-8) - GINV
(H15-23)
G - W-B
Motor shutdown signal
Power switch ON
(READY), N position
0.2 to 0.7
MSDN (H15-8) - GINV
(H15-23)
G - W-B
Motor shutdown signal
Power switch ON
(READY), P position
5.1 to 13.6
OVH (H15-22) - GINV
(H15-23)
BR - W-B
Motor inverter over
voltage signal
Power switch ON (IG),
inverter normal
5.3 to 7.3
OVH (H15-22) - GINV
(H15-23)
BR - W-B
Motor inverter over
voltage signal
Power switch ON (IG),
inverter abnormal
1.9 to 2.9
MFIV (H15-18) - GINV
(H15-23)
G - W-B
Motor inverter fail signal
Power switch ON (IG),
inverter normal
5.4 to 7.4
MFIV (H15-18) - GINV
(H15-23)
G - W-B
Motor inverter fail signal
Power switch ON (IG),
inverter abnormal
2 to 3
MRF (H17-34) - MRFG
(H17-33)
L-P
Motor resolver signal
Motor resolver stopped or
rotating
Pulse generation
(see waveform 11, 12)
MSN (H17-20) - MSNG
(H17-19)
G-R
Motor resolver signal
Motor resolver stopped or
rotating
Pulse generation
(see waveform 11, 12)
MCS (H17-32) - MCSG
(H17-31)
Y - BR
Motor resolver signal
Motor resolver stopped or
rotating
Pulse generation
(see waveform 11, 12)
MMT (H17-18) - MMTG
(H17-28)
B-R
No. 1 motor temperature
sensor
Refer to DATA LIST (see
page HV-49)
-
VL (H16-30) - GCNV
(H16-8)
Y-G
Boost converter input
voltage
Power switch ON
(READY)
1.9 to 3.4
OVL (H16-22) - GCNV
(H16-8)
B-G
Boost converter over
voltage signal
Power switch ON (IG),
boost converter normal
5.3 to 7.7
OVL (H16-22) - GCNV
(H16-8)
B-G
Boost converter over
voltage signal
Power switch ON (IG),
boost converter abnormal
1.9 to 3.0
FCV (H16-20) - GCNV
(H16-8)
W-G
Boost converter fail signal
Power switch ON (IG),
boost converter normal
5.3 to 7.7
FCV (H16-20) - GCNV
(H16-8)
W-G
Boost converter fail signal
Power switch ON (IG),
boost converter abnormal
1.9 to 3.0
CT (H16-21) - GCNV
(H16-8)
R-G
Boost converter
temperature sensor
Power switch ON (IG)
2.0 to 4.5
CPWM (H16-10) - GCNV
(H16-8)
B-G
Boost converter PWM
switch signal
Power switch ON
(READY), parking brake
ON, D position, brake
pedal and accelerator
pedal depressed
Pulse generation
(see waveform 14)
CSDN (H16-9) - GCNV
(H16-8)
W-G
Boost converter shutdown
signal
Power switch ON (IG)
5.6 or higher
CSDN (H16-9) - GCNV
(H16-8)
W-G
Boost converter shutdown
signal
Power switch ON
(READY)
Below 0.7
ST1- (H15-2) - GND1
(H14-1)
G - W-B
Stop light switch (opposite
to STP)
Power switch ON (IG) and
brake pedal depressed
Below 0.5
ST1- (H15-2) - GND1
(H14-1)
G - W-B
Stop light switch (opposite
to STP)
Power switch ON (IG) and
brake pedal released
9 to 14
CCS (H14-13) - GND1
(H14-1)
V - W-B
Cruise control switch
Cruise control system Terminal of ECU - CCS
terminal
(see page CC-9)
-
HV
HV–32
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
STD Voltage (V)
IMI (H14-18) - GND1
(H14-1)
W - W-B
Immobiliser
communication
Immobiliser
communicating
Pulse generation
(see waveform 15)
IMO (H14-26) - GND1
(H14-1)
R - W-B
Immobiliser
communication
Immobiliser
communicating
Pulse generation
(see waveform 15)
P1 (H15-17) - GND1 (H141)
Y - W-B
P position switch
Power switch ON (IG), P
position switch ON
3 to 5
P1 (H15-17) - GND1 (H141)
Y - W-B
P position switch
Power switch ON (IG), P
position switch OFF
7 to 12
PCON (H17-9) - GND1
(H14-1)
LG - W-B
P position control signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Pulse generation
(see waveform 16)
PPOS (H17-10) - GND1
(H14-1)
W - W-B
P position signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Pulse generation
(see waveform 16)
RDY (H14-28) - GND1
(H14-1)
R - W-B
READY control signal
Power switch ON (IG)
Pulse generation
(see waveform 17)
RDY (H14-28) - GND1
(H14-1)
R - W-B
READY control signal
Power switch ON
(READY)
Pulse generation
(see waveform 18)
CLK (H16-17) - GND1
(H14-1)
G - W-B
A/C communication
Power switch ON (IG), A/C
operating
Pulse generation
(see waveform 19)
ITE (H16-14) - GND1
(H14-1)
Y - W-B
A/C communication
Power switch ON (IG), A/C
operating
Pulse generation
(see waveform 19)
ETI (H15-24) - GND1
(H14-1)
R - W-B
A/C communication
Power switch ON (IG), A/C
operating
Pulse generation
(see waveform 19)
STB (H15-25) - GND1
(H14-1)
W - W-B
A/C communication
Power switch ON (IG), A/C
operating
Pulse generation
(see waveform 19)
WP (H16-5) - GND1 (H141)
O - W-B
Water pump relay control
Power switch ON (IG), A/C
operating
Below 2
GND1 (H14-1) - Body
ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always (resistance check)
Below 5 Ω
GND2 (H14-4) - Body
ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always (resistance check)
Below 5 Ω
HV
GND
A092069E01
1.
Oscilloscope waveforms
HINT:
In the oscilloscope waveform samples, which are
provided here for informational purposes. Noise and
fluttering waveforms have been omitted.
2.
Waveform 1
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Item
Contents
Terminal
CANH - GND1
Equipment Setting
1 V/Division, 2 µs/Division
Condition
Power switch ON (IG)
HINT:
The waveform varies depending on the contents of
communication.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
3.
GND
HV–33
Waveform 2
LOW-level CAN bus line
Item
Contents
Terminal
CANL - GND1
Equipment Setting
1 V/Division, 2 µs/Division
Condition
Power switch ON (IG)
HINT:
The waveform varies depending on the contents of
communication.
A092070E01
4.
Waveform 3
Engine speed signal
Item
Contents
Terminal
NEO - GND1
Equipment Setting
1 V/Division, 2 ms/Division
Condition
Engine idling
HINT:
The pulse cycle becomes shorter as the engine speed
increases.
GND
A092071E01
5.
Waveform 4
G signal
Item
Contents
Terminal
GO - GND1
Equipment Setting
2 V/Division, 20 ms/Division
Condition
Engine idling
HV
GND
A092072E01
6.
Waveform 5
Vehicle speed signal
Item
GND
Contents
Terminal
SPDI - GND1
Equipment Setting
5 V/Division, 20 ms/Division
Condition
Driving at approximately 20 km/h (12
mph)
HINT:
The higher the vehicle speed, the shorter the cycle and
higher the voltage.
A092073E01
7.
*1
Waveform 6
Airbag deployment signal
Item
GND
*2
*2
A092074E01
Contents
Terminal
ABFS - GND1
Equipment Setting
1 V/Division, 500 ms/Division
Condition
Power switch ON (READY) (2 seconds
after ON [ACC]) Airbag system normal
*1: 1 frame
*2: 500 ms
HV–34
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HINT:
The waveform on the left is repeated when the airbag
system is normal.
8.
*1
GND
*2
*3
Item
Contents
Terminal
ABFS - GND1
Equipment Setting
1 V/Division, 50 ms/Division
Condition
Power switch ON (READY) (2 seconds
after ON [ACC]) Airbag system
abnormal
*1: 1 frame
*2: 40 ms
*3: 60 ms
HINT:
The waveform on the left is repeated when the airbag
system is abnormal.
A092075E01
9.
*1
GND
*2
*3
*4
Waveform 7
Airbag deployment signal
Waveform 8
Airbag deployment signal
Item
Contents
Terminal
ABFS - GND1
Equipment Setting
1 V/Division, 50 ms/Division
Condition
Power switch ON (READY) (2 seconds
after ON [ACC]) Airbag system
deployed (during collision)
*5
*1: 1 frame
*2: 20 ms
*3: 140 ms
*4: 100 ms
*5: 60 ms
HINT:
When the airbag system is deployed, after 1 frame of
transmission indicating a normal condition is completed,
the waveform on the left is repeated for 50 frames. After
that, normal transmission returns.
A092076E01
HV
10. Waveform 9
System main relay signal
CH1
GND
CH2
GND
CH3
GND
CH4
GND
A092077E01
Item
Contents
Terminal
CH1: IGSW - GND1
CH2: CON1 - GND1
CH3: CON2 - GND1
CH4: CON3 - GND1
Equipment Setting
10 V/Division, 100 ms/Division
Condition
Power switch OFF to ON (READY)
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–35
11. Waveform 10
Generator switch U, V, and W signal
CH1
GND
CH2
GND
CH3
GND
Item
Contents
Terminal
CH1: GUU - GINV
CH2: GVU - GINV
CH3: GWU - GINV
Equipment Setting
10 V/Division, 20 µs/Division
Condition
Power switch ON (IG)
A092078E01
12. Waveform 11
Generator or motor resolver
CH1
GND
CH2
GND
CH3
GND
Item
Contents
Terminal
(Generator Resolver)
CH1: GRF - GRFG
CH2: GSN - GSNG
CH3: GCS - GCSG
Terminal
(Motor Resolver)
CH1: MRF - MRFG
CH2: MSN - MSNG
CH3: MCS - MCSG
Equipment Setting
CH1: 10 V/Division, 1 ms/Division
CH2, 3: 5 V/Division, 1 ms/Division
Condition
Generator or motor stopped
A092079E01
HINT:
The phases and the waveform height of the GSN and
GCS, or the MSN and MCS change depending on the
stopped position of the rotor.
13. Waveform 12
Generator or motor resolver
CH1
GND
CH2
GND
CH3
GND
A
Item
Contents
Terminal
(Generator Resolver)
CH1: GRF - GRFG
CH2: GSN - GSNG
CH3: GCS - GCSG
Terminal
(Motor Resolver)
CH1: MRF - MRFG
CH2: MSN - MSNG
CH3: MCS - MCSG
Equipment Setting
CH1: 10 V/Division, 1 ms/Division
CH2, 3: 5 V/Division, 1 ms/Division
Condition
Generator or motor rotating
A092080E01
HINT:
Distance "A" in the diagram becomes shorter as the rotor
speed increases.
14. Waveform 13
Motor switch U, V, and W signal
CH1
CH2
GND
GND
CH3
GND
A092081E01
Item
Contents
Terminal
CH1: MUU - GINV
CH2: MVU - GINV
CH3: MWU - GINV
Equipment Setting
10 V/Division, 50 µs/Division
Condition
Power switch ON (IG)
HV
HV–36
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
15. Waveform 14
Boost converter PWM switch signal
GND
Item
Contents
Terminal
CPWM - GCNV
Equipment Setting
10 V/Division, 50 µs/Division
Condition
Power switch ON (READY), parking
brake ON, D position, brake pedal and
accelerator pedal depressed
A092082E01
16. Waveform 15
Immobiliser communication
CH1
GND
CH2
Item
Contents
Terminal
CH1: IMO - GND1
CH2: IMI - GND1
Equipment Setting
5 V/Division, 200 ms/Division
Condition
Immobiliser communicating
GND
A092083E01
17. Waveform 16
P position control signal, P position signal
CH1
GND
CH2
HV
Item
Contents
Terminal
CH1: PCON - GND1
CH2: PPOS - GND1
Equipment Setting
5 V/Division, 20 ms/Division
Condition
Power switch ON (IG)
GND
A092084E01
18. Waveform 17
READY control signal
Item
Contents
Terminal
RDY - GND1
Equipment Setting
2 V/Division, 20 ms/Division
Condition
Power switch ON (IG)
GND
A092085E01
19. Waveform 18
READY control signal
GND
A092086E01
Item
Contents
Terminal
RDY - GND1
Equipment Setting
2 V/Division, 20 ms/Division
Condition
Power switch ON (READY)
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–37
20. Waveform 19
A/C communication
CH1
Item
Contents
Terminal
CH1: IGSW - GND1
CH2: ITE - GND1
CH3: CLK - GND1
CH4: ETI - GND1
CH5: STB - GND1
CH2
GND
GND
CH3
CH4
CH5
GND
GND
Equipment Setting
10 V/Division, 50 ms/Division
GND
Condition
Power switch ON (IG) and A/C
operating
A092087E01
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
1.
Master Warning Light
A014089E01
DESCRIPTION
(a) The HV control ECU has a self-diagnosis system. If
the computer, hybrid vehicle control system or the
components are not working properly, the ECU
carries out a diagnosis to detect the malfunctions,
and illuminates the master warning light in the
combination meter together with indicators on the
multi display, the HV system warning, the HV
battery warning or the discharge warning.
HINT:
The master warning light illuminates when THS II
fails and it blinks when in inspection mode.
Discharge Warning
HV System Warning
HV Battery Warning
HV
A087660E01
FI00534E01
• When troubleshooting OBD II vehicles, the only
difference from the usual troubleshooting
procedure is that you need to connect the OBD II
scan tool complying with ISO 15031-4 or the
intelligent tester to the vehicle, and read various
data output from the vehicle's ECUs
• OBD II regulations require that the vehicle's onboard computer illuminates the Malfunction
Indicator Lamp (MIL) in the instrument panel
when the computer detects a malfunction in: 1)
the emission control systems/components, or 2)
the powertrain control components (which affect
vehicle emissions), or 3) the computers. In
addition, the applicable Diagnostic Trouble
Codes (DTCs) prescribed by ISO 15031-4 are
recorded in the HV control ECU memory (see
page HV-55).
If the malfunction does not recur in 3 consecutive
trips, the MIL will go off automatically. However, the
DTCs remain recorded in the HV control ECU
memory.
HV–38
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
• To check the DTCs, connect the intelligent tester
to the Data Link Connector 3 (DLC3) with the
CAN vehicle interface module (CAN VIM). The
intelligent tester enables you to erase the DTCs
and check the freeze frame data and various
forms of THS II data (for operating instructions,
refer to their respective instruction manuals). The
DTCs include SAE controlled codes and
manufacturer controlled codes. SAE controlled
codes must be set as prescribed by the SAE,
while manufacturer controlled codes can be set
by a manufacturer within the prescribed limits
(see page HV-55).
• Freeze frame data:
The freeze frame data records the driving
condition when malfunction is detected. When
troubleshooting, it can help determine if the
vehicle was moving, braking, stationary, or
reversing.
Intelligent Tester
CAN VIM
DLC3
A082795E01
2.
DLC3
CHECK DLC3
The HV control ECU uses the ISO 15765-4
communication protocol. The terminal arrangement of
the DLC3 complies with ISO 15031-03 and matches the
ISO 15765-4 format.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 1112131415 16
A082779E98
HV
Symbol
Terminal No.
Name
Reference Terminal
Result
Condition
SIL
7
Bus "+" line
5 - Signal ground
Pulse generation
During transmission
CG
4
Chassis ground
Body ground
1 Ω or less
Always
SG
5
Signal ground
Body ground
1 Ω or less
Always
BAT
16
Battery positive
Body ground
11 to 14 V
Always
CANH
6
HIGH-level CAN bus
line
14 - LOW-level CAN
bus line
54 to 69 Ω
Power switch OFF*
CANH
6
HIGH-level CAN bus
line
16 - Battery positive
1 MΩ or higher
Power switch OFF*
CANH
6
HIGH-level CAN bus
line
4 - Chassis ground
200 Ω or higher
Power switch OFF*
CANL
14
LOW-level CAN bus
line
16 - Battery positive
1 MΩ or higher
Power switch OFF*
CANL
14
LOW-level CAN bus
line
4 - Chassis ground
200 Ω or higher
Power switch OFF*
NOTICE:
*: Before measuring the resistance, leave the vehicle
as is for at least 1 minute and do not operate the
power switch, other switches or doors.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
3.
4.
HV–39
If the result is not as specified, the DLC3 may have a
malfunction. Repair or replace the harness and
connector.
HINT:
If the display shows UNABLE TO CONNECT TO
VEHICLE when you have connected the cable of the
intelligent tester to the DLC3, turned the power switch
ON (IG) and operated the tester, there is a problem on
the vehicle side or tester side.
• If communication is normal when the tester or scan
tool is connected to another vehicle, inspect the DLC3
on the original vehicle.
• If communication is still not possible when the tester
or scan tool is connected to another vehicle, the
problem is probably in the tester or scan tool itself, so
consult the Service Department listed in its instruction
manual.
INSPECT AUXILIARY BATTERY
(a) Measure the voltage of the auxiliary battery.
Standard voltage:
11 to 14 V
(b) Inspect the auxiliary battery, fusible links, wire
harness, connectors and ground.
CHECK MIL
(a) The MIL illuminates when the power switch is turned
ON (IG) and the "READY" light is OFF.
If the MIL is not illuminated, troubleshoot the MIL
circuit (see page ES-428).
HV
FI00534E01
(b) When the "READY" light turns on, the MIL should
turn off.
If the MIL remains on, the diagnosis system has
detected a malfunction or abnormality in the system.
A087700E01
HV–40
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC CHECK / CLEAR
Intelligent Tester
DLC3
1.
CHECK DTC (HV ECU)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and turn the
intelligent tester ON.
(c) Using the intelligent tester, check the DTCs and
freeze frame data and then write them down.
For the intelligent tester, enter the following menus:
DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD / HV ECU / DTC INFO /
CURRENT CODES.
(d) Confirm the details of the DTCS (see page HV-55).
2.
CHECK FREEZE DATA AND INFORMATION
(a) If a DTC is present, select that DTC in order to
display its freeze frame data.
CAN VIM
A082795E01
A136965
HV
INF
Code
A136966E01
(b) Read freeze frame data recorded when the DTC
was set.
NOTICE:
An information code (INF code) is displayed in
one of the INFORMATION lines 1 to 5. Check the
details by following the procedures in the
following steps.
HINT:
In the case shown in the illustration, refer to
troubleshooting for DTC P3140 and INF code 350.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–41
(c) Read the information.
(1) Select the item that has an INF code from
among INFORMATION 1 to 5 on the freeze
frame data screen.
(2) Press ENTER.
INF
Code
A136966E01
3.
A136967
4.
(3) Information is displayed as shown in the
illustration.
CHECK DTC (SYSTEMS OTHER THAN HV ECU)
HINT:
The HV control ECU maintains mutual communication
with the computers, including the ECM, battery ECU,
skid control ECU, power steering ECU and other
components. Therefore, if the HV control ECU outputs a
warning, it is necessary to check and record the DTCs of
all the systems.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and turn the
intelligent tester ON.
(c) For the intelligent tester, enter the following menus:
DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD / CODES (ALL).
(d) If DTCs are present, check the relevant systems.
HINT:
If DTCs for the CAN communication system are
present in addition to other DTCs, first troubleshoot
and repair any malfunctions in the CAN
communication (see page CA-6).
CLEAR DTC
NOTICE:
Clearing the DTCs will also clear the freeze frame
data, information (see page HV-86) and operation
history data (see page HV-89).
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and turn the
intelligent tester ON.
(c) Check that the shift position is in P.
(d) Clear DTCs and freeze frame data with the
intelligent tester.
For the intelligent tester:
(1) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/
MOBD / HV ECU / DTC INFO / CLEAR CODES.
(2) Press YES.
HV
HV–42
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
FAIL-SAFE CHART
1.
FAIL-SAFE CHART
DTC No.
Detection Item
INF Code
Driving Condition
B2799
Immobiliser malfunction
539
Impossible to drive
B2799
Immobiliser malfunction
540
Impossible to drive
B2799
Immobiliser malfunction
541
Impossible to drive
B2799
Immobiliser malfunction
542
Impossible to drive
B2799
Immobiliser malfunction
543
Impossible to drive
B2799
Immobiliser malfunction
544
Impossible to drive
P0336
Crankshaft Position Sensor "A"
Circuit Range / Performance
137
Normal driving
P0338
Crankshaft Position Sensor "A"
Circuit High Input
600
Normal driving
P0340
Camshaft Position Sensor "A"
Circuit
532
Normal driving
P0343
Camshaft Position Sensor "A"
Circuit High Input
601
Normal driving
P0500
Vehicle Speed Sensor "A"
352
Cruise control driving impossible
P0560
System Voltage
117
Normal driving
P0571
Brake Switch "A" Circuit
115
Cruise control driving impossible
P0607
Control Module Performance
116
Cruise control driving impossible
P0705
Transmission Range Sensor
Circuit
571
If shift position cannot be fixed:
Impossible to drive
If shift position is being fixed:
Normal driving
P0705
Transmission Range Sensor
Circuit
572
If shift position cannot be fixed:
Impossible to drive
If shift position is being fixed:
Normal driving
P0705
Transmission Range Sensor
Circuit
573
If shift position cannot be fixed:
Impossible to drive
If shift position is being fixed:
Normal driving
P0705
Transmission Range Sensor
Circuit
574
If shift position cannot be fixed:
Impossible to drive
If shift position is being fixed:
Normal driving
P0705
Transmission Range Sensor
Circuit
575
If shift position cannot be fixed:
Impossible to drive
If shift position is being fixed:
Normal driving
P0705
Transmission Range Sensor
Circuit
576
If shift position cannot be fixed:
Impossible to drive
If shift position is being fixed:
Normal driving
P0705
Transmission Range Sensor
Circuit
577
If shift position cannot be fixed:
Impossible to drive
If shift position is being fixed:
Normal driving
P0705
Transmission Range Sensor
Circuit
578
If shift position cannot be fixed:
Impossible to drive
If shift position is being fixed:
Normal driving
P0705
Transmission Range Sensor
Circuit
595
If shift position cannot be fixed:
Impossible to drive
If shift position is being fixed:
Normal driving
HV
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–43
DTC No.
Detection Item
INF Code
Driving Condition
P0705
Transmission Range Sensor
Circuit
596
If shift position cannot be fixed:
Impossible to drive
If shift position is being fixed:
Normal driving
P0851
Park / Neutral Switch Input Circuit
Low
579
If shift position cannot be fixed:
Impossible to drive
If shift position is being fixed:
Normal driving
P0852
Park / Neutral Switch Input Circuit
High
580
If shift position cannot be fixed:
Impossible to drive
If shift position is being fixed:
Normal driving
P0A08
DC / DC Converter Status Circuit
264
Normal driving
P0A09
DC / DC Converter Status Circuit
Low Input
265
Normal driving
P0A09
DC / DC Converter Status Circuit
Low Input
591
Normal driving
P0A0D
High Voltage System Inter-lock
Circuit High
350
Normal driving
P0A0D
High Voltage System Inter-lock
Circuit High
351
Normal driving
P0A0F
Engine Failed to Start
204
Limited driving
P0A0F
Engine Failed to Start
205
Limited driving
P0A0F
Engine Failed to Start
238
Limited driving
P0A0F
Engine Failed to Start
533
Limited driving
P0A0F
Engine Failed to Start
534
Limited driving
P0A10
DC / DC Converter Status Circuit
High Input
263
Normal driving
P0A10
DC / DC Converter Status Circuit
High Input
592
Normal driving
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
134
Impossible to drive
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
135
Impossible to drive
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
139
Normal driving
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
140
Impossible to drive
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
141
Impossible to drive
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
142
Impossible to drive
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
143
Impossible to drive
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
144
Impossible to drive
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
145
Impossible to drive
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
148
Impossible to drive
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
149
Impossible to drive
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
150
Limited driving
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
151
Limited driving
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
152
Limited driving
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
155
Limited driving
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
156
Limited driving
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
158
Limited driving
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
159
Impossible to drive
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
160
Impossible to drive
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
163
Impossible to drive
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
164
Impossible to drive
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
165
Limited driving
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
166
Normal driving
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
167
Limited driving
HV
HV–44
HV
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC No.
Detection Item
INF Code
Driving Condition
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
168
Limited driving
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
177
Impossible to drive
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
178
Impossible to drive
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
180
Limited driving
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
181
Limited driving
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
182
Limited driving
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
183
Limited driving
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
184
Limited driving
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
185
Limited driving
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
186
Limited driving
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
187
Impossible to drive
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
188
Limited driving
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
189
Limited driving
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
192
Limited driving
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
193
Limited driving
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
195
Limited driving
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
196
Limited driving
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
197
Limited driving
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
198
Normal driving
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
199
Limited driving
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
200
Limited driving
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
390
Limited driving
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
392
Impossible to drive
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
393
Impossible to drive
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
511
Impossible to drive
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
512
Impossible to drive
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
564
Limited driving
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
565
Limited driving
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
567
Impossible to drive
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
568
Limited driving
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
569
Limited driving
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
570
Impossible to drive
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
615
Limited driving
P0A1F
Battery Energy Control Module
123
Limited driving
P0A1F
Battery Energy Control Module
129
Limited driving
P0A1F
Battery Energy Control Module
593
Normal driving
P0A2B
Drive Motor "A" Temperature
Sensor Circuit Range /
Performance
248
Normal driving
P0A2B
Drive Motor "A" Temperature
Sensor Circuit Range /
Performance
250
Normal driving
P0A2C
Drive Motor "A" Temperature
Sensor Circuit Low
247
Normal driving
P0A2D
Drive Motor "A" Temperature
Sensor Circuit High
249
Normal driving
P0A37
Generator Temperature Sensor
Circuit Range / Performance
258
Normal driving
P0A37
Generator Temperature Sensor
Circuit Range / Performance
260
Normal driving
P0A38
Generator Temperature Sensor
Circuit Low
257
Normal driving
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC No.
Detection Item
INF Code
Driving Condition
P0A39
Generator Temperature Sensor
Circuit High
259
Normal driving
P0A3F
Drive Motor "A" Position Sensor
Circuit
243
Limited driving
P0A40
Drive Motor "A" Position Sensor
Circuit Range / Performance
500
Limited driving
P0A41
Drive Motor "A" Position Sensor
Circuit Low
245
Limited driving
P0A4B
Generator Position Sensor Circuit
253
Limited driving
P0A4C
Generator Position Sensor Circuit
Range / Performance
513
Limited driving
P0A4D
Generator Position Sensor Circuit
Low
255
Limited driving
P0A51
Drive Motor "A" Current Sensor
Circuit
174
Limited driving
P0A60
Drive Motor "A" Phase V Current
288
Limited driving
P0A60
Drive Motor "A" Phase V Current
289
Limited driving
P0A60
Drive Motor "A" Phase V Current
290
Limited driving
P0A60
Drive Motor "A" Phase V Current
292
Limited driving
P0A60
Drive Motor "A" Phase V Current
294
Limited driving
P0A60
Drive Motor "A" Phase V Current
501
Limited driving
P0A63
Drive Motor "A" Phase W Current
296
Limited driving
P0A63
Drive Motor "A" Phase W Current
297
Limited driving
P0A63
Drive Motor "A" Phase W Current
298
Limited driving
P0A63
Drive Motor "A" Phase W Current
300
Limited driving
P0A63
Drive Motor "A" Phase W Current
302
Limited driving
P0A63
Drive Motor "A" Phase W Current
502
Limited driving
P0A72
Generator Phase V Current
326
Limited driving
P0A72
Generator Phase V Current
327
Limited driving
P0A72
Generator Phase V Current
328
Limited driving
P0A72
Generator Phase V Current
330
Limited driving
P0A72
Generator Phase V Current
333
Limited driving
P0A72
Generator Phase V Current
515
Limited driving
P0A75
Generator Phase W Current
334
Limited driving
P0A75
Generator Phase W Current
335
Limited driving
P0A75
Generator Phase W Current
336
Limited driving
P0A75
Generator Phase W Current
338
Limited driving
P0A75
Generator Phase W Current
341
Limited driving
P0A75
Generator Phase W Current
516
Limited driving
P0A78
Drive Motor "A" Inverter
Performance
266
Limited driving
P0A78
Drive Motor "A" Inverter
Performance
267
Limited driving
P0A78
Drive Motor "A" Inverter
Performance
272
Normal driving
P0A78
Drive Motor "A" Inverter
Performance
278
Normal driving
P0A78
Drive Motor "A" Inverter
Performance
279
Limited driving
P0A78
Drive Motor "A" Inverter
Performance
280
Normal driving
P0A78
Drive Motor "A" Inverter
Performance
282
Limited driving
HV–45
HV
HV–46
HV
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC No.
Detection Item
INF Code
Driving Condition
P0A78
Drive Motor "A" Inverter
Performance
283
Normal driving
P0A78
Drive Motor "A" Inverter
Performance
284
Limited driving
P0A78
Drive Motor "A" Inverter
Performance
285
Normal driving
P0A78
Drive Motor "A" Inverter
Performance
286
Limited driving
P0A78
Drive Motor "A" Inverter
Performance
287
Limited driving
P0A78
Drive Motor "A" Inverter
Performance
304
Normal driving
P0A78
Drive Motor "A" Inverter
Performance
305
Normal driving
P0A78
Drive Motor "A" Inverter
Performance
306
Limited driving
P0A78
Drive Motor "A" Inverter
Performance
308
Impossible to drive
P0A78
Drive Motor "A" Inverter
Performance
503
Limited driving
P0A78
Drive Motor "A" Inverter
Performance
504
Limited driving
P0A78
Drive Motor "A" Inverter
Performance
505
Limited driving
P0A78
Drive Motor "A" Inverter
Performance
506
Limited driving
P0A78
Drive Motor "A" Inverter
Performance
507
Normal driving
P0A78
Drive Motor "A" Inverter
Performance
508
Normal driving
P0A78
Drive Motor "A" Inverter
Performance
510
Normal driving
P0A78
Drive Motor "A" Inverter
Performance
523
Limited driving
P0A78
Drive Motor "A" Inverter
Performance
586
Limited driving
P0A7A
Generator Inverter Performance
309
Limited driving
P0A7A
Generator Inverter Performance
321
Normal driving
P0A7A
Generator Inverter Performance
322
Limited driving
P0A7A
Generator Inverter Performance
323
Normal driving
P0A7A
Generator Inverter Performance
324
Limited driving
P0A7A
Generator Inverter Performance
325
Limited driving
P0A7A
Generator Inverter Performance
342
Limited driving
P0A7A
Generator Inverter Performance
343
Limited driving
P0A7A
Generator Inverter Performance
344
Limited driving
P0A7A
Generator Inverter Performance
517
Limited driving
P0A7A
Generator Inverter Performance
518
Limited driving
P0A7A
Generator Inverter Performance
519
Limited driving
P0A7A
Generator Inverter Performance
520
Limited driving
P0A7A
Generator Inverter Performance
522
Normal driving
P0A90
Drive Motor "A" Performance
239
Limited driving
P0A90
Drive Motor "A" Performance
240
Limited driving
P0A90
Drive Motor "A" Performance
241
Limited driving
P0A90
Drive Motor "A" Performance
242
Limited driving
P0A90
Drive Motor "A" Performance
251
Limited driving
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC No.
Detection Item
INF Code
Driving Condition
P0A90
Drive Motor "A" Performance
509
Limited driving
P0A90
Drive Motor "A" Performance
602
Limited driving
P0A90
Drive Motor "A" Performance
604
Limited driving
P0A90
Drive Motor "A" Performance
605
Limited driving
P0A92
Hybrid Generator Performance
261
Limited driving
P0A92
Hybrid Generator Performance
521
Limited driving
P0A92
Hybrid Generator Performance
606
Limited driving
P0A92
Hybrid Generator Performance
607
Limited driving
P0A93
Inverter Cooling System
Performance
346
Limited driving
P0A93
Inverter Cooling System
Performance
347
Limited driving
P0A94
DC / DC Converter Performance
442
Limited driving
P0A94
DC / DC Converter Performance
545
Limited driving
P0A94
DC / DC Converter Performance
546
Limited driving
P0A94
DC / DC Converter Performance
547
Limited driving
P0A94
DC / DC Converter Performance
548
Limited driving
P0A94
DC / DC Converter Performance
549
Limited driving
P0A94
DC / DC Converter Performance
550
Limited driving
P0A94
DC / DC Converter Performance
551
Limited driving
P0A94
DC / DC Converter Performance
552
Limited driving
P0A94
DC / DC Converter Performance
553
Limited driving
P0A94
DC / DC Converter Performance
554
Limited driving
P0A94
DC / DC Converter Performance
555
Limited driving
P0A94
DC / DC Converter Performance
556
Limited driving
P0A94
DC / DC Converter Performance
557
Limited driving
P0A94
DC / DC Converter Performance
558
Normal driving
P0A94
DC / DC Converter Performance
559
Limited driving
P0A94
DC / DC Converter Performance
560
Normal driving
P0A94
DC / DC Converter Performance
561
Limited driving
P0A94
DC / DC Converter Performance
583
Normal driving
P0A94
DC / DC Converter Performance
584
Normal driving
P0A94
DC / DC Converter Performance
585
Normal driving
P0A94
DC / DC Converter Performance
587
Limited driving
P0A94
DC / DC Converter Performance
588
Limited driving
P0A94
DC / DC Converter Performance
589
Normal driving
P0A94
DC / DC Converter Performance
590
Normal driving
P0AA1
Hybrid Battery Positive Contactor
Circuit Stuck Closed
231
Impossible to drive
P0AA1
Hybrid Battery Positive Contactor
Circuit Stuck Closed
233
Impossible to drive
P0AA4
Hybrid Battery Negative
Contactor Circuit Stuck Closed
232
Limited driving
P0AA6
Hybrid Battery Voltage System
Isolation Fault
526
Normal driving*
P0AA6
Hybrid Battery Voltage System
Isolation Fault
611
Normal driving*
P0AA6
Hybrid Battery Voltage System
Isolation Fault
612
Normal driving*
P0AA6
Hybrid Battery Voltage System
Isolation Fault
613
Normal driving*
HV–47
HV
HV–48
HV
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC No.
Detection Item
INF Code
Driving Condition
P0AA6
Hybrid Battery Voltage System
Isolation Fault
614
Normal driving*
P0ADB
Hybrid Battery Positive Contactor
Control Circuit Low
227
Impossible to drive
P0ADC
Hybrid Battery Positive Contactor
Control Circuit High
226
Impossible to drive
P0ADF
Hybrid Battery Negative
Contactor Control Circuit Low
229
Impossible to drive
P0AE0
Hybrid Battery Negative
Contactor Control Circuit High
228
Impossible to drive
P0AE6
Hybrid Battery Precharge
Contactor Control Circuit Low
225
Normal driving
P0AE7
Hybrid Battery Precharge
Contactor Control Circuit High
224
Normal driving
P0AEE
Motor Inverter Temperature
Sensor "A" Circuit Range /
Performance
276
Normal driving
P0AEE
Motor Inverter Temperature
Sensor "A" Circuit Range /
Performance
277
Normal driving
P0AEF
Drive Motor Inverter Temperature
Sensor "A" Circuit Low
275
Normal driving
P0AF0
Drive Motor Inverter Temperature
Sensor "A" Circuit High
274
Normal driving
P2120
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor /
Switch "D" Circuit
111
Limited driving
P2121
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor /
Switch "D" Circuit Range /
Performance
106
Limited driving
P2121
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor /
Switch "D" Circuit Range /
Performance
114
Limited driving
P2122
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor /
Switch "D" Circuit Low Input
104
Limited driving
P2123
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor /
Switch "D" Circuit High Input
105
Limited driving
P2125
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor /
Switch "E" Circuit
112
Limited driving
P2126
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor /
Switch "E" Circuit Range /
Performance
109
Limited driving
P2127
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor /
Switch "E" Circuit Low Input
107
Limited driving
P2128
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor /
Switch "E" Circuit High Input
108
Limited driving
P2138
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor /
Switch "D" / "E" Voltage
Correlation
110
Limited driving
P3000
HV Battery Malfunction
123
Limited driving
P3000
HV Battery Malfunction
125
Limited driving
P3000
HV Battery Malfunction
388
Limited driving
P3000
HV Battery Malfunction
389
Limited driving
P3000
HV Battery Malfunction
603
Limited driving
P3004
Power Cable Malfunction
131
Impossible to drive
P3004
Power Cable Malfunction
132
Normal driving
P3004
Power Cable Malfunction
133
Limited driving
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–49
DTC No.
Detection Item
INF Code
Driving Condition
P3102
Transmission Control ECU
Malfunction
524
Impossible to drive
P3102
Transmission Control ECU
Malfunction
525
Impossible to drive
P3102
Transmission Control ECU
Malfunction
581
If shift position cannot be fixed:
Impossible to drive
If shift position is being fixed:
Normal driving
P3102
Transmission Control ECU
Malfunction
582
If shift position cannot be fixed:
Impossible to drive
If shift position is being fixed:
Normal driving
P3102
Transmission Control ECU
Malfunction
597
If shift position cannot be fixed:
Impossible to drive
If shift position is being fixed:
Normal driving
P3102
Transmission Control ECU
Malfunction
598
If shift position cannot be fixed:
Impossible to drive
If shift position is being fixed:
Normal driving
P3102
Transmission Control ECU
Malfunction
599
If shift position cannot be fixed:
Impossible to drive
If shift position is being fixed:
Normal driving
P3107
Airbag ECU Communication
Circuit Malfunction
213
Normal driving
P3107
Airbag ECU Communication
Circuit Malfunction
214
Normal driving
P3107
Airbag ECU Communication
Circuit Malfunction
215
Normal driving
P3108
A/C Amplifier Communication
Circuit Malfunction
535
Normal driving
P3108
A/C Amplifier Communication
Circuit Malfunction
536
Normal driving
P3108
A/C Amplifier Communication
Circuit Malfunction
537
Normal driving
P3108
A/C Amplifier Communication
Circuit Malfunction
538
Normal driving
P3108
A/C Amplifier Communication
Circuit Malfunction
594
Normal driving
P3110
IGCT Relay Malfunction
223
Normal driving
P3110
HV Main Relay Malfunction
527
Impossible to drive
P3137
Collision Sensor Low Input
348
Normal driving
P3138
Collision Sensor High Input
349
Normal driving
P3221
Generator Inverter Temperature
Sensor Circuit Range /
Performance
314
Normal driving
P3221
Generator Inverter Temperature
Sensor Circuit Range /
Performance
315
Normal driving
P3222
Generator Inverter Temperature
Sensor Circuit High / Low
313
Normal driving
P3223
Generator Inverter Temperature
Sensor Circuit High
312
Normal driving
P3226
DC / DC Boost Converter
Temperature Sensor Malfunction
562
Normal driving
P3226
DC / DC Boost Converter
Temperature Sensor Malfunction
563
Normal driving
HV
HV–50
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC No.
Detection Item
INF Code
Driving Condition
U0100
Lost Communication with ECM /
PCM "A"
211
Limited driving
U0100
Lost Communication with ECM /
PCM "A"
212
Limited driving
U0100
Lost Communication with ECM /
PCM "A"
530
Limited driving
U0111
Lost Communication with Battery
Energy Control Module "A"
208
Limited driving
U0111
Lost Communication with Battery
Energy Control Module "A"
531
Limited driving
U0129
Lost Communication with Brake
System Control Module
220
Regenerative brake ineffective
U0129
Lost Communication with Brake
System Control Module
222
Regenerative brake ineffective
U0129
Lost Communication with Brake
System Control Module
528
Regenerative brake ineffective
U0129
Lost Communication with Brake
System Control Module
529
Regenerative brake ineffective
U0131
Lost Communication with Power
Steering Control Module
433
Normal driving
U0131
Lost Communication with Power
Steering Control Module
434
Normal driving
U0146
Lost Communication with
Gateway "A"
435
Normal driving
HINT:
*: Normal driving occurs but turning the power switch
OFF once causes driving to become impossible.
HV
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–51
DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST
1.
DATA LIST
NOTICE:
• The value of the DATA LIST may vary significantly
if there are slight differences in measurement,
differences in the environment in which the
measurements are obtained, or the aging of the
vehicle. Thus, definite standards or judgment
values are unavailable. Therefore, there may be a
malfunction even if a measured value is within the
reference range.
• In the event of intricate symptoms, collect sample
data from another vehicle of the same model
operating under identical conditions, in order to
reach an overall judgment by comparing all the
items of DATA LIST.
HINT:
Using the DATA LIST displayed on the intelligent tester,
you can read values including those of the switches,
sensors, actuators, without removing any parts . Reading
the DATA LIST as the first step of troubleshooting is one
method to shorten diagnostic time.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/
MOBD / HV ECU / DATA LIST.
(e) Check the results by referring to the following table.
Intelligent Tester Display
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Reference Range
Diagnostic Note
COOLANT TEMP
Engine coolant temperature /
Min.: -40°C, Max.: 140°C
After warming up:
80 to 100°C (176 to 212°F)
•
•
VEHICLE SPD
Vehicle speed /
Min.: 0 km/h, Max.: 255 km/h
Vehicle stopped: 0 km/h (0 mph)
-
ENG RUN TIME
Elapsed time after starting engine
/
Min.: 0 s, Max.: 65,535 s
-
-
+B
Auxiliary battery voltage /
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 65.535 V
Constant:
Auxiliary battery voltage +-3 V
-
ACCEL POS #1
No. 1 accelerator pedal position
sensor /
Min.: 0%, Max.: 100%
Accelerator pedal depressed:
Changes with accelerator pedal
pressure
-
ACCEL POS #2
No. 2 accelerator pedal position
sensor /
Min.: 0%, Max.: 100%
Accelerator pedal depressed:
Changes with accelerator pedal
pressure
-
AMBIENT TEMP
Ambient air temperature /
Min.: -40°C, Max.: 215°C
Power switch ON (IG):
Same as ambient air temperature
-
INTAKE AIR TEMP
Intake air temperature /
Min.: -40°C, Max.: 140°C
Constant:
Same as ambient air temperature
-
DTC CLEAR WARM
The number of times engine is
warmed up after clearing DTCs /
Min.: 0, Max.: 255
MIL OFF, engine coolant
temperature increases from
below 22°C (71.6°F) before
starting the engine to above 70°C
(158°F) after starting the engine:
Increases once
-
The value is -40°C (-40°F):
Open in sensor circuit
If the value is 140°C (284°F):
Short in sensor circuit
HV
HV–52
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Intelligent Tester Display
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Reference Range
Diagnostic Note
DTC CLEAR RUN
Drive distance after clearing
DTCs /
Min.: 0 km, Max.: 65,535 km
-
-
DTC CLEAR MIN
Elapsed time after clearing DTCs
/
Min.: 0 min, Max.: 65,535 min
-
-
MIL ON RUN DIST
Drive distance after malfunction
occurrence /
Min.: 0 km, Max.: 65,535 km
-
-
MIL ON ENG TIME
Elapsed time after starting engine
with MIL ON /
Min.: 0 min, Max.: 65,535 min
-
-
MIL Status
MIL status / ON or OFF
MIL ON: ON
Constant ON:
Repair in accordance with
detected DTCs
MG2 REV
MG2 revolution /
Min.: -16,383 rpm, Max.: 16,383
rpm
-
-
MG2 TORQ
MG2 torque /
Min.: -500 Nm, Max.: 500 Nm
-
-
MG2 TRQ EXC VAL
MG2 torque execution value /
Min.: -512 Nm, Max.: 508 Nm
After full-load acceleration with
READY light ON and engine
stopped:
Less than +-20% of MG2 TORQ
-
MG1 REV
MG1 revolution /
Min.: -16,383 rpm, Max.: 16,383
rpm
-
-
MG1 TORQ
MG1 torque /
Min.: -500 Nm, Max.: 500 Nm
-
-
MG1 TRQ EXC VAL
MG1 torque execution value /
Min.: -512 Nm, Max.: 508 Nm
1 second has elapsed after the
engine was started automatically
with READY light ON, engine
stopped, A/C fan Hi, headlight ON
and the P position:
Less than +-20% of MG1 TORQ
-
REGEN EXEC TORQ
Regenerative brake execution
torque /
Min.: 0 Nm, Max.: 186 Nm
-
-
REGEN RQST TORQ
Regenerative brake request
torque /
Min.: 0 Nm, Max.: 186 Nm
Vehicle speed 30 km/h (19 mph)
and master cylinder hydraulic
pressure -200 Nm:
Changes with brake pedal
pressure
-
MG1 INVERT TEMP
MG1 inverter temperature /
Min.: -50°C, Max.: 205°C
•
Undisturbed for 1 day at 25°C
(77°F): 25°C (77°F)
Street driving:
25 to 80°C (77 to 176°F)
•
Undisturbed for 1 day at 25°C
(77°F): 25°C (77°F)
Street driving:
25 to 80°C (77 to 176°F)
•
Undisturbed for 1 day at 25°C
(77°F): 25°C (77°F)
Street driving:
25 to 80°C (77 to 176°F)
•
HV
•
MG2 INVERT TEMP
MG2 inverter temperature /
Min.: -50°C, Max.: 205°C
•
•
MOTOR2 TEMP
Transaxle fluid temperature /
Min.: -50°C, Max.: 205°C
•
•
•
•
•
If the value is -50°C (-58°F):
+B short in sensor circuit
If the value is 205°C (401°F):
Open or GND short in sensor
circuit
If the value is -50°C (-58°F):
+B short in sensor circuit
If the value is 205°C (401°F):
Open or GND short in sensor
circuit
If the value is -50°C (-58°F):
Open or +B short in sensor
circuit
If the value is 205°C (401°F):
GND short in sensor circuit
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Intelligent Tester Display
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Reference Range
Diagnostic Note
MOTOR1 TEMP
MG2 motor temperature /
Min.: -50°C, Max.: 205°C
•
Undisturbed for 1 day at 25°C
(77°F): 25°C (77°F)
Street driving:
25 to 80°C (77 to 176°F)
•
Undisturbed for 1 day at 25°C
(77°F): 25°C (77°F)
Street driving:
25 to 60°C (77 to 140°F)
•
•
CONVERTER TEMP
Boost converter temperature /
Min.: -50°C, Max.: 205°C
•
•
•
•
ACCEL DEG
Accelerator pedal depressed
angle /
Min.: 0%, Max.: 100%
Accelerator pedal depressed:
Changes with accelerator pedal
pressure
-
POWER RQST
Engine power output request
value /
Min.: 0 W, Max.: 320,000 W
-
-
TARGET ENG SPD
Target engine speed /
Min.: 0 rpm, Max.: 8,000 rpm
-
-
ENGINE SPD
Engine speed /
Min.: 0 rpm, Max.: 8,000 rpm
Idling*: 950 to 1,050 rpm
-
VEHICLE SPD
Resolver vehicle speed /
Min.: -256 km/h, Max.: 254 km/h
Driving at 40 km/h (25 mph):
40 km/h (25 mph)
-
MCYL CTRL POWER
Braking torque that is equivalent
to the master cylinder hydraulic
pressure /
Min.: -512 Nm, Max.: 508 Nm
Brake pedal depressed:
Changes with brake pedal
pressure
-
SOC
Battery state of charge /
Min.: 0%, Max.: 100%
Constant: 0 to 100%
-
WOUT CTRL POWER
Discharge control power value /
Min.: 0 W, Max.: 81,600 W
21,000 W or less
-
WIN CTRL POWER
Charge control power value /
Min.: -40,800 W, Max.: 0 W
-25,000 W or more
-
DCHG RQST SOC
Discharge request to adjust SOC
/
Min.: -20,480 W, Max.: 20,320 W
•
-
PWR RESOURCE VB
HV battery voltage /
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 510 V
READY light ON and P position:
150 to 300 V
-
PWR RESOURCE IB
HV battery current /
Min.: -256 A, Max.: 254 A
-
-
VL
High voltage before it is boosted /
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 510 V
Power switch ON (READY):
Practically the same as the HV
battery voltage
•
•
Uniform on-board charging: 4,400 W
Usually: 0 W
•
VH
High voltage after it is boosted /
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 765 V
Engine revved up in P position:
HV battery voltage to 500 V
•
•
RAIS PRES RATIO
Boost ratio /
Min.: 0%, Max.: 100%
The pre-boost voltage and the
post-boost voltage are equal:
0 to 10%
-
DRIVE CONDITION
Drive condition ID /
Min.: 0, Max.: 6
•
•
-
•
•
•
•
Engine stopped: 0
Engine about to be stopped:
1
Engine about to be started: 2
Engine operated or operating:
3
Generating or loading
movement: 4
Revving up with P position: 6
HV–53
If the value is -50°C (-58°F):
Open or +B short in sensor
circuit
If the value is 205°C (401°F):
GND short in sensor circuit
If the value is -50°C (-58°F):
+B short in sensor circuit
If the value is 205°C (401°F):
Open or GND short in sensor
circuit
HV
If the value is 0 V:
Open or GND short in sensor
circuit
If the value is 510 V:
+B short in sensor circuit
If the value is 0 V:
Open or GND short in sensor
circuit
If the value is 765 V:
+B short in sensor circuit
HV–54
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Intelligent Tester Display
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Reference Range
Diagnostic Note
M SHIFT SENSOR
Output voltage of the shift
position sensor (main) /
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 5 V
•
Selector lever in home
position:
2.0 to 3.0 V
Shifting into R position:
4.0 to 4.8 V
Shifting into B or D position:
0.2 to 1.0 V
-
Selector lever in home
position:
2.0 to 3.0 V
Shifting into R position:
4.0 to 4.8 V
Shifting into B or D position:
0.2 to 1.0 V
-
Selector lever in home
position:
0.5 to 2.0 V
Shifting into R, N or D
position:
3.0 to 4.85 V
-
Selector lever in home
position:
0.5 to 2.0 V
Shifting into R, N or D
position:
3.0 to 4.85 V
-
•
•
S SHIFT SENSOR
Output voltage of the shift
position sensor (sub) /
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 5 V
•
•
•
SM SHIFT SENSOR
Output voltage of the select
position sensor (main) /
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 5 V
•
•
SS SHIFT SENSOR
Output voltage of the select
position sensor (sub) /
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 5 V
•
•
SHIFT POSITION
Shift position
P, R, N, D or B
-
A/C CONSMPT PWR
A/C consumption power /
Min.: 0 kW, Max.: 5 kW
-
-
DRIVE CONDITION
Driving condition
•
•
SHORT WAVE HIGH
Waveform voltage in leak
detection circuit in battery ECU /
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 5 V
READY light is left ON for 2
minutes, and the pre-boost
voltage and the post-boost
voltage are equal:
4 V or more
ECU TYPE
Type of ECU
HV ECU
-
CURRENT DTC
The number of current DTCs /
Min.: 0, Max.: 255
-
-
HISTORY DTC
The number of history DTCs /
Min.: 0, Max.: 255
-
-
CHECK MODE
Check mode /
ON or OFF
-
-
ENG STOP RQST
Engine stop request /
NO or RQST
Requesting engine stop:
RQST
-
IDLING REQUEST
Engine idling request /
NO or RQST
Requesting idle:
RQST
-
HV BATT CH RQST
HV battery charging request /
NO or RQST
Requesting HV battery charging:
RQST
-
AIRCON REQUEST
Engine starting request from air
conditioning amplifier /
NO or RQST
Requesting engine start from air
conditioning amplifier:
RQST
-
ENG WARM UP RQT
Engine warm-up request /
NO or RQST
Requesting engine warm-up:
RQST
-
SMR CONT1
Operating condition of No. 1
system main relay /
ON or OFF
Power switch ON (READY):
OFF
-
SMR CONT2
Operating condition of No. 2
system main relay /
ON or OFF
Power switch ON (READY):
ON
-
HV
MG1 load: MG1
MG2 load: MG2
-
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Intelligent Tester Display
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Reference Range
Diagnostic Note
SMR CONT3
Operating condition of No. 3
system main relay /
ON or OFF
Power switch ON (READY):
ON
-
MG1 GATE
MG1 gate status /
ON or OFF
ON
-
MG2 GATE
MG2 gate status /
ON or OFF
Shutting down motor inverter:
ON
-
CNV GATE
Boost converter gate status /
ON or OFF
Shutting down boost converter:
ON
-
A/C GATE
A/C gate status /
ON or OFF
Shutting down A/C inverter:
ON
-
ENTRY KEY ECU
Electronic key ID code check
status /
ON or OFF
When electronic key ID code
corresponds to ID code
registered in ECU:
ON
-
2.
HV–55
HINT:
*: If no conditions are specifically stated for "Idling",
it means the engine for inspection mode, the shift
position is in P, the A/C switch is OFF, and
accelerator pedal is not depressed.
ACTIVE TEST
NOTICE:
Beware that if the connector to the intelligent tester
becomes disconnected or a communication error
occurs during the ACTIVE TEST, the vehicle could
become inoperative (READY light OFF).
HINT:
Performing the ACTIVE TEST using the intelligent tester
enables components including the relay, VSV, and
actuator, to be operated without removing any parts.
Performing the ACTIVE TEST as the first step of
troubleshooting is one method to shorten diagnostic
time.
It is possible to display items in the DATA LIST during the
ACTIVE TEST.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/
MOBD / HV ECU / ACTIVE TEST.
(e) According to the display on the tester, perform the
ACTIVE TEST.
Intelligent Tester Display
Purpose
Test Details
Test Condition
INSPECTION MOD1*1, *2
•
•
Power switch ON (IG), HV system
normal, not in inspection mode,
and other Active Tests not being
executed
•
To check its operation while
the engine is running
To disable traction control
while performing a
speedometer test or other
test
•
Runs the engine continuously
(P position)
Cancels the traction control
that is effected when the
rotational difference between
the front and rear wheels is
excessive (other than the P
position)
HV
HV–56
HV
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Intelligent Tester Display
Purpose
Test Details
Test Condition
INSPECTION MOD2*1, *2
To disable traction control while
performing a speedometer test or
the like
Cancels the traction control that is
effected when the rotational
difference between the front and
rear wheels is excessive (other
than the P position)
Power switch ON (IG), HV system
normal, not in inspection mode,
and other Active Tests not being
executed
INVERTER STOP*1
To determine if there is an internal
leak in the inverter or the HV
control ECU
Keeps the inverter power
transistor actuation signal ON
Power switch ON (IG), P position,
HV system normal, inverter
actuation not being disabled,
shutting down inverter, and other
Active Tests not being executed
COMPRESS TEST*1, *3, *4
To crank the engine continuously
in order to measure the
compression
Allows the engine to continue
cranking by activating the
generator continuously
Power switch ON (IG), HV system
normal, not in cranking mode,
and other Active Tests not being
executed
NOTICE:
*1: The intelligent tester displays a
communication error and the vehicle's READY
light turns OFF when the ACTIVE TEST is
completed. Therefore, in order to use the tester
again, turn the power switch OFF, and restart by
turning it ON.
*2: After turning on INSPECTION MOD1 or
MOD2, push the power switch while depressing
the brake pedal.
*3: After turning on COMPRESS TEST, push the
power switch while depressing the brake pedal.
To stop engine cranking, push the power switch
again.
*4: COMPRESS TEST may not be activated
depending on the condition of the engine or the
HV battery.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–57
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
DTC No.
Detection Item
DTC Detection
Condition
Trouble Area
Master
Warning Light
MIL
Memory
See page
P0336-137
Crankshaft
Position Sensor
"A" Circuit
Range /
Performance
Engine speed
sensor
deviation
malfunction
(CAN
communication
)
- Wire harness
or connector
- Crankshaft
position sensor
- Camshaft
position sensor
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-91
P0338-600
Crankshaft
Position Sensor
"A" Circuit High
Input
NEO signal
circuit
malfunction
- Wire harness
or connector
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-94
P0340-532
Camshaft
Position Sensor
"A" Circuit
Engine speed
sensor
deviation
malfunction
(pulse signal)
- Wire harness
or connector
- Crankshaft
position sensor
- Camshaft
position sensor
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-91
P0343-601
Camshaft
Position Sensor
"A" Circuit High
Input
GO signal
circuit
malfunction
- Wire harness
or connector
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-94
P0560-117
System Voltage
HV control ECU
back-up power
source circuit
malfunction
- Wire harness
or connector
- HEV fuse
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-97
P0630-804
VIN not
Programmed or
Mismatch-ECM
/ PCM
- VIN not stored
in HV control
ECU
- Input
VIN in HV
control ECU not
accurate
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-101
P0705-571
Transmission
Range Sensor
Circuit
Open or GND
short in shift
main sensor
circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Selector lever
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-102
P0705-572
Transmission
Range Sensor
Circuit
+B short in shift
main sensor
circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Selector lever
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-102
P0705-573
Transmission
Range Sensor
Circuit
Open or GND
short in shift
sub sensor
circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Selector lever
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-102
P0705-574
Transmission
Range Sensor
Circuit
+B short in shift
sub sensor
circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Selector lever
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-102
P0705-575
Transmission
Range Sensor
Circuit
Open or GND
short in select
main sensor
circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Selector lever
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-102
HV
HV–58
DTC No.
HV
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Detection Item
DTC Detection
Condition
Trouble Area
Master
Warning Light
MIL
Memory
See page
P0705-576
Transmission
Range Sensor
Circuit
+B short in
select main
sensor circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Selector lever
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-102
P0705-577
Transmission
Range Sensor
Circuit
Open or GND
short in select
sub sensor
circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Selector lever
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-102
P0705-578
Transmission
Range Sensor
Circuit
+B short in
select sub
sensor circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Selector lever
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-102
P0705-595
Transmission
Range Sensor
Circuit
Difference
between shift
main sensor
value and shift
sub sensor
value is large
- Wire harness
or connector
- Selector lever
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-102
P0705-596
Transmission
Range Sensor
Circuit
Difference
between select
main sensor
value and
select sub
sensor value is
large
- Wire harness
or connector
- Selector lever
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-102
P0851-579
Park / Neutral
Switch Input
Circuit Low
GND short in P
position switch
circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- P position
switch
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-112
P0852-580
Park / Neutral
Switch Input
Circuit High
Open or +B
short in P
position switch
circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- P position
switch
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-112
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC No.
Trouble Area
Master
Warning Light
MIL
Memory
HV–59
Detection Item
DTC Detection
Condition
See page
P0A08-264
DC / DC
Converter
Status Circuit
DC / DC
converter
malfunction
- Auxiliary
battery
- Fusible link
block assembly
- HV control
ECU
- Fuse (for 12 V
electrical
equipment)
- Engine room
relay block
- Inverter
cooling hose
- Water pump
with motor
assembly
- Cooling fan
motor
- No.2 cooling
fan motor
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly (DC /
DC converter)
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-115
P0A09-265
DC / DC
Converter
Status Circuit
Low Input
Open or GND
short in NODD
signal circuit of
DC / DC
converter
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-124
P0A09-591
DC / DC
Converter
Status Circuit
Low Input
Open or GND
short in VLO
signal circuit of
DC / DC
converter
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-127
P0A0D-350
High Voltage
System InterLock Circuit
High
Operating
safety devices
with vehicle
stopped (ILK
signal is ON)
- Service plug
grip installation
- Inverter cover
installation
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-129
P0A0D-351
High Voltage
System InterLock Circuit
High
Open in
interlock signal
circuit while
vehicle is
running
- Wire harness
or connector
- Battery plug
(No. 2 interlock
switch)
- Inverter with
converter
assembly (No.
1 interlock
switch)
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-130
P0A0F-204
Engine Failed
to Start
Abnormal
signal input
from ECM
(abnormal
engine output)
- ECM
- SFI system
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-134
P0A0F-205
Engine Failed
to Start
Abnormal
signal input
from ECM
(engine is
unable to start)
- ECM
- SFI system
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-134
HV
HV–60
DTC No.
HV
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Detection Item
DTC Detection
Condition
Trouble Area
Master
Warning Light
MIL
Memory
See page
P0A0F-238
Engine Failed
to Start
Engine does
not start even
though
cranking it
(transaxle input
malfunction
[engine
system])
- Engine
assembly
- HV transaxle
assembly (shaft
or gear)
- Transmission
input damper
- Wire harness
or connector
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-135
P0A0F-533
Engine Failed
to Start
Abnormal
signal input
from ECM
(abnormal
engine output
by running out
of fuel)
- ECM
- SFI system
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-134
P0A0F-534
Engine Failed
to Start
Abnormal
signal input
from ECM
(engine is
unable to start
by running out
of fuel)
- ECM
- SFI system
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-134
P0A10-263
DC / DC
Converter
Status Circuit
High Input
+B short in
NODD signal
circuit of DC /
DC converter
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-124
P0A10-592
DC / DC
Converter
Status Circuit
High Input
+B short in
NODD signal
circuit of DC /
DC converter
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-127
P0A1D-134
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-141
P0A1D-135
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-141
P0A1D-139
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-143
P0A1D-140
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-144
P0A1D-141
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-145
P0A1D-142
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
ST signal of HV
control ECU is
ON with power
switch OFF
- Wire harness
or connector
- Power source
control ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-146
P0A1D-143
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-149
P0A1D-144
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-150
P0A1D-145
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-150
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Trouble Area
Master
Warning Light
MIL
Memory
HV–61
DTC No.
Detection Item
DTC Detection
Condition
See page
P0A1D-148
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-152
P0A1D-149
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-152
P0A1D-150
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-154
P0A1D-151
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-154
P0A1D-152
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-154
P0A1D-155
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-154
P0A1D-156
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-154
P0A1D-158
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-154
P0A1D-159
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-156
P0A1D-160
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-156
P0A1D-163
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-158
P0A1D-164
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-158
P0A1D-165
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-160
P0A1D-166
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-162
P0A1D-167
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-162
P0A1D-168
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-160
P0A1D-177
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-164
P0A1D-178
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-164
P0A1D-180
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-166
P0A1D-181
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-166
HV
HV–62
HV
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC No.
Detection Item
DTC Detection
Condition
Trouble Area
Master
Warning Light
MIL
Memory
See page
P0A1D-182
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-166
P0A1D-183
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-166
P0A1D-184
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-166
P0A1D-185
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-166
P0A1D-186
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-166
P0A1D-187
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-168
P0A1D-188
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-169
P0A1D-189
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-169
P0A1D-192
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-169
P0A1D-193
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-169
P0A1D-195
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-169
P0A1D-196
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-169
P0A1D-197
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-162
P0A1D-198
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-160
P0A1D-199
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-160
P0A1D-200
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-162
P0A1D-390
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
Charge control
malfunction
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-171
P0A1D-392
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-164
P0A1D-393
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-172
P0A1D-511
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-158
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Trouble Area
Master
Warning Light
MIL
Memory
HV–63
DTC No.
Detection Item
DTC Detection
Condition
See page
P0A1D-512
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-158
P0A1D-564
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-154
P0A1D-565
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-169
P0A1D-567
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-164
P0A1D-568
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-173
P0A1D-569
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-173
P0A1D-570
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-141
P0A1D-615
Hybrid
Powertrain
Control Module
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-175
P0A1F-123
Battery Energy
Control Module
Abnormal
signal input
from battery
ECU (ROM/
RAM
malfunction)
- HV battery
system
- Battery ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-177
P0A1F-129
Battery Energy
Control Module
HV battery
voltage circuit
malfunction
- HV battery
voltage circuit
- Service plug
grip
- High voltage
fuse
- Battery plug
- Battery ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-179
HV
P0A1F-593
Battery Energy
Control Module
IG2 signal
circuit of battery
ECU
malfunction
- Wire harness
or connector
- Battery ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-183
P0A2B-248
Drive Motor "A"
Temperature
Sensor Circuit
Range /
Performance
No. 1 motor
temperature
sensor
malfunction
- Hybrid vehicle
motor
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-186
P0A2B-250
Drive Motor "A"
Temperature
Sensor Circuit
Range /
Performance
No. 1 motor
temperature
sensor
performance
problem
- Hybrid vehicle
motor
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-186
P0A2C-247
Drive Motor "A"
Temperature
Sensor Circuit
Low
GND short in
No. 1 motor
temperature
sensor circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Hybrid vehicle
motor
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-187
HV–64
HV
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC No.
Detection Item
DTC Detection
Condition
Trouble Area
Master
Warning Light
MIL
Memory
See page
P0A2D-249
Drive Motor "A"
Temperature
Sensor Circuit
High
Open or +B
short in No. 1
motor
temperature
sensor circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Hybrid vehicle
motor
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-187
P0A37-258
Generator
Temperature
Sensor Circuit
Range /
Performance
No. 2 motor
temperature
sensor
malfunction
- Hybrid vehicle
motor
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-193
P0A37-260
Generator
Temperature
Sensor Circuit
Range /
Performance
No. 2 motor
temperature
sensor
performance
problem
- Hybrid vehicle
motor
- Transaxle
fluid leakage
- HV transaxle
assembly
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-194
P0A38-257
Generator
Temperature
Sensor Circuit
Low
GND short in
No. 2 motor
temperature
sensor circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Hybrid vehicle
motor
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-195
P0A39-259
Generator
Temperature
Sensor Circuit
High
Open or +B
short in No. 2
motor
temperature
sensor circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Hybrid vehicle
motor
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-195
P0A3F-243
Drive Motor "A"
Position Sensor
Circuit
Interphase
short in motor
resolver circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Hybrid vehicle
motor
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-200
P0A40-500
Drive Motor "A"
Position Sensor
Circuit Range /
Performance
Motor resolver
output is out of
normal range
- Wire harness
or connector
- Hybrid vehicle
motor
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-200
P0A41-245
Drive Motor "A"
Position Sensor
Circuit Low
Open or short
in motor
resolver circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Hybrid vehicle
motor
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-200
P0A4B-253
Generator
Position Sensor
Circuit
Interphase
short in
generator
resolver circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Hybrid vehicle
generator
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-205
P0A4C-513
Generator
Position Sensor
Circuit Range /
Performance
Generator
resolver output
is out of normal
range
- Wire harness
or connector
- Hybrid vehicle
generator
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-205
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Master
Warning Light
MIL
Memory
HV–65
DTC No.
Detection Item
DTC Detection
Condition
Trouble Area
See page
P0A4D-255
Generator
Position Sensor
Circuit Low
Open or short
in generator
resolver circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Hybrid vehicle
generator
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-205
P0A51-174
Drive Motor "A"
Current Sensor
Circuit
HV control ECU
internal error
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-209
P0A60-288
Drive Motor "A"
Phase V
Current
Phase V
current sub
sensor of motor
inverter current
sensor
malfunction
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-210
P0A60-289
Drive Motor "A"
Phase V
Current
Open in phase
V current sub
sensor circuit of
motor inverter
current sensor
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-210
P0A60-290
Drive Motor "A"
Phase V
Current
Phase V
current main
sensor of motor
inverter current
sensor
malfunction
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-210
P0A60-292
Drive Motor "A"
Phase V
Current
Open in phase
V current main
sensor circuit of
motor inverter
current sensor
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-210
P0A60-294
Drive Motor "A"
Phase V
Current
Phase V
current main
and sub
sensors of
motor inverter
current sensor
performance
problem
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-210
HV
P0A60-501
Drive Motor "A"
Phase V
Current
Phase V
current main
and sub
sensors of
motor inverter
current sensor
offset
malfunction
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-210
P0A63-296
Drive Motor "A"
Phase W
Current
Phase W
current sub
sensor of motor
inverter current
sensor
malfunction
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-210
P0A63-297
Drive Motor "A"
Phase W
Current
Open in phase
W current sub
sensor circuit of
motor inverter
current sensor
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-210
P0A63-298
Drive Motor "A"
Phase W
Current
Phase W
current main
sensor of motor
inverter current
sensor
malfunction
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-210
HV–66
HV
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC No.
Detection Item
DTC Detection
Condition
Trouble Area
Master
Warning Light
MIL
Memory
See page
P0A63-300
Drive Motor "A"
Phase W
Current
Open in phase
W current main
sensor circuit of
motor inverter
current sensor
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-210
P0A63-302
Drive Motor "A"
Phase W
Current
Phase W
current main
and sub
sensors of
motor inverter
current sensor
performance
problem
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-210
P0A63-502
Drive Motor "A"
Phase W
Current
Phase W
current main
and sub
sensors of
motor inverter
current sensor
offset
malfunction
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-210
P0A72-326
Generator
Phase V
Current
Phase V
current sub
sensor of
generator
inverter current
sensor
malfunction
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-215
P0A72-327
Generator
Phase V
Current
Open in phase
V current sub
sensor circuit of
generator
inverter current
sensor
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-215
P0A72-328
Generator
Phase V
Current
Phase V
current main
sensor of
generator
inverter current
sensor
malfunction
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-215
P0A72-330
Generator
Phase V
Current
Open in phase
V current main
sensor circuit of
generator
inverter current
sensor
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-215
P0A72-333
Generator
Phase V
Current
Phase V
current main
and sub
sensors of
generator
inverter current
sensor
performance
problem
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-215
P0A72-515
Generator
Phase V
Current
Phase V
current main
and sub
sensors of
generator
inverter current
sensor offset
malfunction
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-215
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC No.
Master
Warning Light
MIL
Memory
HV–67
Detection Item
DTC Detection
Condition
Trouble Area
See page
P0A75-334
Generator
Phase W
Current
Phase W
current sub
sensor of
generator
inverter current
sensor
malfunction
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-215
P0A75-335
Generator
Phase W
Current
Open in phase
W current sub
sensor circuit of
generator
inverter current
sensor
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-215
P0A75-336
Generator
Phase W
Current
Phase W
current main
sensor of
generator
inverter current
sensor
malfunction
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-215
P0A75-338
Generator
Phase W
Current
Open in phase
W current main
sensor circuit of
generator
inverter current
sensor
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-215
P0A75-341
Generator
Phase W
Current
Phase W
current main
and sub
sensors of
generator
inverter current
sensor
performance
problem
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-215
P0A75-516
Generator
Phase W
Current
Phase W
current main
and sub
sensors of
generator
inverter current
sensor offset
malfunction
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-215
P0A78-266
Drive Motor "A"
Inverter
Performance
Open or GND
short in inverter
voltage (VH)
signal circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-220
P0A78-267
Drive Motor "A"
Inverter
Performance
+B short in
inverter voltage
(VH) signal
circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-220
P0A78-272
Drive Motor "A"
Inverter
Performance
Abnormality in
motor PWM
circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-228
HV
HV–68
HV
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC No.
Detection Item
DTC Detection
Condition
Trouble Area
Master
Warning Light
MIL
Memory
See page
P0A78-278
Drive Motor "A"
Inverter
Performance
+B short in
motor inverter
over-voltage
(OVH) signal
circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-231
P0A78-279
Drive Motor "A"
Inverter
Performance
Motor inverter
over-voltage
(OVH) signal
detection (overvoltage by
inverter
assembly
malfunction)
- Wire harness
or connector
- HV transaxle
assembly
- Hybrid vehicle
motor
- Hybrid vehicle
generator
- HV control
ECU
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-234
P0A78-280
Drive Motor "A"
Inverter
Performance
Open or GND
short in motor
inverter overvoltage (OVH)
signal circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-231
P0A78-282
Drive Motor "A"
Inverter
Performance
Motor inverter
over voltage
(OVH) signal
detection
(circuit
malfunction)
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-243
P0A78-283
Drive Motor "A"
Inverter
Performance
+B short in
motor inverter
fail (MFIV)
signal circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-247
P0A78-284
Drive Motor "A"
Inverter
Performance
Motor inverter
fail (MFIV)
signal detection
(inverter
overheating)
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter
cooling system
- Water pump
with motor
assembly
- Cooling fan
motor
- No. 2 cooling
fan motor
- HV transaxle
assembly
- Hybrid vehicle
motor
- HV control
ECU
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-250
P0A78-285
Drive Motor "A"
Inverter
Performance
Open or GND
short in motor
inverter fail
(MFIV) signal
circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-247
P0A78-286
Drive Motor "A"
Inverter
Performance
Motor inverter
fail (MFIV)
signal detection
(circuit
malfunction)
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-258
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC No.
Detection Item
DTC Detection
Condition
Trouble Area
P0A78-287
Drive Motor "A"
Inverter
Performance
Motor inverter
fail (MFIV)
signal detection
(over current by
inverter
assembly
malfunction)
- Wire harness
or connector
- HV transaxle
assembly
- Hybrid vehicle
motor
- HV control
ECU
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-261
P0A78-304
Drive Motor "A"
Inverter
Performance
Open or +B
short in motor
gate shutdown
(MSDN) signal
circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-268
P0A78-305
Drive Motor "A"
Inverter
Performance
GND short in
motor gate
shutdown
(MSDN) signal
circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-268
P0A78-306
Drive Motor "A"
Inverter
Performance
Failure in
monitoring
MG2 torque
performance
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-271
P0A78-308
Drive Motor "A"
Inverter
Performance
Collision signal
input from
center airbag
sensor or No. 1
circuit breaker
sensor
- Supplemental
restraint
system
- No. 1 circuit
breaker sensor
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-274
P0A78-503
Drive Motor "A"
Inverter
Performance
Motor inverter
over-voltage
(OVH) signal
detection (overvoltage by HV
control ECU
malfunction)
- Wire harness
or connector
- HV transaxle
assembly
- Hybrid vehicle
motor
- Hybrid vehicle
generator
- HV control
ECU
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-234
Drive Motor "A"
Inverter
Performance
Motor inverter
over-voltage
(OVH) signal
detection (overvoltage by HV
transaxle
assembly
malfunction)
- Wire harness
or connector
- HV transaxle
assembly
- Hybrid vehicle
motor
- Hybrid vehicle
generator
- HV control
ECU
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
P0A78-504
Master
Warning Light
MIL
Memory
HV–69
See page
HV
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-234
HV–70
HV
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC No.
Detection Item
DTC Detection
Condition
Trouble Area
Master
Warning Light
MIL
Memory
See page
P0A78-505
Drive Motor "A"
Inverter
Performance
Motor inverter
fail (MFIV)
signal detection
(over current by
HV control ECU
malfunction)
- Wire harness
or connector
- HV transaxle
assembly
- Hybrid vehicle
motor
- Hybrid vehicle
generator
- HV control
ECU
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-261
P0A78-506
Drive Motor "A"
Inverter
Performance
Motor inverter
fail (MFIV)
signal detection
(over current by
HV transaxle
assembly
malfunction)
- Wire harness
or connector
- HV transaxle
assembly
- Hybrid vehicle
motor
- Hybrid vehicle
generator
- HV control
ECU
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-261
P0A78-507
Drive Motor "A"
Inverter
Performance
Open in motor
gate shutdown
(MSDN) signal
circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-268
P0A78-508
Drive Motor "A"
Inverter
Performance
Motor gate
shutdown
(MSDN) signal
malfunction
- Wire harness
or connector
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-275
P0A78-510
Drive Motor "A"
Inverter
Performance
Motor inverter
gate
malfunction
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-278
P0A78-523
Drive Motor "A"
Inverter
Performance
Inverter voltage
(VH) sensor
offset
malfunction
- System main
relay
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-280
P0A78-586
Drive Motor "A"
Inverter
Performance
Inverter voltage
(VH) sensor
performance
problem
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-282
P0A7A-309
Generator
Inverter
Performance
Abnormality in
generator PWM
circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-285
P0A7A-321
Generator
Inverter
Performance
+B short in
generator
inverter fail
(GFIV) signal
circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-288
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC No.
Trouble Area
Master
Warning Light
MIL
Memory
HV–71
Detection Item
DTC Detection
Condition
See page
P0A7A-322
Generator
Inverter
Performance
Generator
inverter fail
(GFIV) signal
detection
(inverter
overheating)
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter
cooling system
- Water pump
with motor
assembly
- Cooling fan
motor
- No. 2 cooling
fan motor
- HV transaxle
assembly
- Hybrid vehicle
generator
- HV control
ECU
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-291
P0A7A-323
Generator
Inverter
Performance
Open or GND
short in
generator
inverter fail
(GFIV) signal
circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-288
P0A7A-324
Generator
Inverter
Performance
Generator
inverter fail
(GFIV) signal
detection
(circuit
malfunction)
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-299
P0A7A-325
Generator
Inverter
Performance
Generator
inverter fail
(GFIV) signal
detection (over
current by
inverter
assembly
malfunction)
- Wire harness
or connector
- HV transaxle
assembly
- Hybrid vehicle
generator
- HV control
ECU
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-302
HV
P0A7A-342
Generator
Inverter
Performance
Open or +B
short in
generator gate
shutdown
(GSDN) signal
circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-309
P0A7A-343
Generator
Inverter
Performance
GND short in
generator gate
shutdown
(GSDN) signal
circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-309
P0A7A-344
Generator
Inverter
Performance
Failure in
monitoring
MG1 torque
performance
- Hybrid vehicle
generator
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-312
HV–72
DTC No.
HV
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Detection Item
DTC Detection
Condition
Trouble Area
Master
Warning Light
MIL
Memory
See page
P0A7A-517
Generator
Inverter
Performance
Generator
inverter fail
(GFIV) signal
detection (over
current by HV
control ECU
malfunction)
- Wire harness
or connector
- HV transaxle
assembly
- Hybrid vehicle
generator
- HV control
ECU
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-302
P0A7A-518
Generator
Inverter
Performance
Generator
inverter fail
(GFIV) signal
detection (over
current by HV
transaxle
assembly
malfunction)
- Wire harness
or connector
- HV transaxle
assembly
- Hybrid vehicle
generator
- HV control
ECU
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-302
P0A7A-519
Generator
Inverter
Performance
Open in
generator gate
shutdown
(GSDN) signal
circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-309
P0A7A-520
Generator
Inverter
Performance
Generator gate
shutdown
(GSDN) signal
malfunction
- Wire harness
or connector
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-315
P0A7A-522
Generator
Inverter
Performance
Generator
inverter gate
malfunction
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-318
P0A90-239
Drive Motor "A"
Performance
HV transaxle
input
malfunction
(shaft
damaged)
- Engine
assembly
- HV transaxle
assembly (shaft
or gear)
- Transmission
input damper
- Wire harness
or connector
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-321
P0A90-240
Drive Motor "A"
Performance
Generator
locked
- Hybrid vehicle
generator
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-328
P0A90-241
Drive Motor "A"
Performance
HV transaxle
input
malfunction
(torque limiter
slipping)
- Engine
assembly
- HV transaxle
assembly (shaft
or gear)
- Transmission
input damper
- Wire harness
or connector
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-321
P0A90-242
Drive Motor "A"
Performance
Planetary gear
locked
- HV transaxle
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-329
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Master
Warning Light
MIL
Memory
HV–73
DTC No.
Detection Item
DTC Detection
Condition
Trouble Area
See page
P0A90-251
Drive Motor "A"
Performance
MG2 magnetic
force
deterioration or
same phase
short circuit
- Hybrid vehicle
motor
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-330
P0A90-509
Drive Motor "A"
Performance
MG2 system
malfunction
- Hybrid vehicle
motor
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-332
P0A90-602
Drive Motor "A"
Performance
HV transaxle
output
malfunction
- Engine
assembly
- HV transaxle
assembly (shaft
or gear)
- Transmission
input damper
- Wire harness
or connector
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-321
P0A90-604
Drive Motor "A"
Performance
MG2 power
balance
malfunction
(small power
balance)
- Battery
current sensor
- Hybrid vehicle
motor
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-335
P0A90-605
Drive Motor "A"
Performance
MG2 power
balance
malfunction
(large power
balance)
- Battery
current sensor
- Hybrid vehicle
motor
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-335
P0A92-261
Hybrid
Generator
Performance
MG1 magnetic
force
deterioration or
same phase
short circuit
- Hybrid vehicle
generator
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-338
P0A92-521
Hybrid
Generator
Performance
MG1 system
malfunction
- Hybrid vehicle
generator
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-340
P0A92-606
Hybrid
Generator
Performance
MG1 power
balance
malfunction
(small power
balance)
- Battery
current sensor
- Hybrid vehicle
generator
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-343
P0A92-607
Hybrid
Generator
Performance
MG1 power
balance
malfunction
(large power
balance)
- Battery
current sensor
- Hybrid vehicle
generator
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-343
HV
HV–74
HV
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC No.
Detection Item
DTC Detection
Condition
Trouble Area
Master
Warning Light
MIL
Memory
See page
P0A93-346
Inverter
Cooling System
Performance
Inverter cooling
system
malfunction
(water pump
system
malfunction)
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter
cooling system
- Water pump
with motor
assembly
- Cooling fan
motor
- No. 2 cooling
fan motor
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-346
P0A93-347
Inverter
Cooling System
Performance
Inverter cooling
system
malfunction
(electric cooling
fan system
malfunction)
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter
cooling system
- Water pump
with motor
assembly
- Cooling fan
motor
- No. 2 cooling
fan motor
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-346
P0A94-442
DC / DC
Converter
Performance
Abnormal
voltage
execution value
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-350
P0A94-545
DC / DC
Converter
Performance
Open or GND
short in boost
converter overvoltage (OVL)
signal circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-352
P0A94-546
DC / DC
Converter
Performance
+B short in
boost converter
over-voltage
(OVL) signal
circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-352
P0A94-547
DC / DC
Converter
Performance
Boost converter
over voltage
(OVL) signal
detection (over
voltage by HV
control ECU
malfunction)
- Wire harness
or connector
- HV transaxle
assembly
- Hybrid vehicle
motor
- Hybrid vehicle
generator
- HV control
ECU
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-355
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC No.
HV–75
Detection Item
DTC Detection
Condition
Trouble Area
P0A94-548
DC / DC
Converter
Performance
Boost converter
over voltage
(OVL) signal
detection (over
voltage by
inverter
assembly
malfunction)
- Wire harness
or connector
- HV transaxle
assembly
- Hybrid vehicle
motor
- Hybrid vehicle
generator
- HV control
ECU
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-355
P0A94-549
DC / DC
Converter
Performance
Boost converter
over voltage
(OVL) signal
detection (over
voltage by HV
transaxle
assembly
malfunction)
- Wire harness
or connector
- HV transaxle
assembly
- Hybrid vehicle
motor
- Hybrid vehicle
generator
- HV control
ECU
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-355
P0A94-550
DC / DC
Converter
Performance
Boost converter
over-voltage
(OVL) signal
detection
(circuit
malfunction)
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-363
P0A94-551
DC / DC
Converter
Performance
Open or GND
short in boost
converter fail
(FCV) signal
circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-366
P0A94-552
DC / DC
Converter
Performance
+B short in
boost converter
fail (FCV)
signal circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-366
P0A94-553
DC / DC
Converter
Performance
Boost converter
fail (FCV)
signal detection
(boost
converter
overheating)
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter
cooling system
- Water pump
with motor
assembly
- Cooling fan
motor
- No. 2 cooling
fan motor
- HV transaxle
assembly
- Hybrid vehicle
motor
- Hybrid vehicle
generator
- HV control
ECU
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-369
Master
Warning Light
MIL
Memory
See page
HV
HV–76
DTC No.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Detection Item
DTC Detection
Condition
Trouble Area
P0A94-554
DC / DC
Converter
Performance
Boost converter
fail (FCV)
signal detection
(over current by
HV control ECU
malfunction)
- Wire harness
or connector
- HV transaxle
assembly
- Hybrid vehicle
motor
- Hybrid vehicle
generator
- HV control
ECU
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-378
P0A94-555
DC / DC
Converter
Performance
Boost converter
fail (FCV)
signal detection
(over current by
inverter
assembly
malfunction)
- Wire harness
or connector
- HV transaxle
assembly
- Hybrid vehicle
motor
- Hybrid vehicle
generator
- HV control
ECU
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-378
P0A94-556
DC / DC
Converter
Performance
Boost converter
fail (FCV)
signal detection
(over current by
HV transaxle
assembly
malfunction)
- Wire harness
or connector
- HV transaxle
assembly
- Hybrid vehicle
motor
- Hybrid vehicle
generator
- HV control
ECU
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-378
P0A94-557
DC / DC
Converter
Performance
Boost converter
fail (FCV)
signal detection
(circuit
malfunction)
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-386
P0A94-558
DC / DC
Converter
Performance
GND short in
boost converter
gate shutdown
(CSDN) signal
circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-389
P0A94-559
DC / DC
Converter
Performance
Open or +B
short in boost
converter gate
shutdown
(CSDN) signal
circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-389
P0A94-560
DC / DC
Converter
Performance
Open in boost
converter gate
shutdown
(CSDN) signal
circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-389
P0A94-561
DC / DC
Converter
Performance
Abnormal boost
converter gate
shutdown
(CSDN) signal
- Wire harness
or connector
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-392
HV
Master
Warning Light
MIL
Memory
See page
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC No.
Trouble Area
Master
Warning Light
MIL
Memory
HV–77
Detection Item
DTC Detection
Condition
See page
P0A94-583
DC / DC
Converter
Performance
Open or GND
short in boost
converter
temperature
sensor circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-395
P0A94-584
DC / DC
Converter
Performance
+B short in
boost converter
temperature
sensor circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-395
P0A94-585
DC / DC
Converter
Performance
Boost converter
voltage (VL)
sensor
performance
problem
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-401
P0A94-587
DC / DC
Converter
Performance
Difference
between
voltages from
HV battery
voltage (VB)
sensor and
boost converter
voltage (VL)
sensor is large
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
- Service plug
grip
- High voltage
fuse
- Battery ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-404
P0A94-588
DC / DC
Converter
Performance
Abnormality in
boost converter
PWM circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-409
P0A94-589
DC / DC
Converter
Performance
Open or GND
short in boost
converter
voltage (VL)
signal circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-412
P0A94-590
DC / DC
Converter
Performance
+B short in
boost converter
voltage (VL)
signal circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-412
P0AA1-231
Hybrid Battery
Positive
Contactor
Circuit Stuck
Closed
System main
relay terminal
of HV battery
positive side
stuck closed
- No. 1 system
main relay
- No. 2 system
main relay
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-418
P0AA1-233
Hybrid Battery
Positive
Contactor
Circuit Stuck
Closed
System main
relay terminals
of HV battery
positive and
negative sides
stuck closed
- No. 1 system
main relay
- No. 2 system
main relay
- No. 3 system
main relay
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-419
P0AA4-232
Hybrid Battery
Negative
Contactor
Circuit Stuck
Closed
System main
relay terminal
of HV battery
negative side
stuck closed
- No. 3 system
main relay
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-420
HV
HV–78
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC No.
Detection Item
DTC Detection
Condition
Trouble Area
P0AA6-526
Hybrid Battery
Voltage System
Isolation Fault
Insulation
resistance of
high voltage
circuit and body
is low
- Frame wire
- System main
relay
- System main
resistor
- HV battery
assembly
- Electric
inverter
compressor
- Battery ECU
- HV transaxle
assembly
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
- Main battery
cable
- No. 2 main
battery cable
- Battery plug
- No. 2 frame
wire
- Junction block
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-421
P0AA6-611
Hybrid Battery
Voltage System
Isolation Fault
Insulation
resistance of A/
C compressor
motor or A/C
inverter is low
- Electric
inverter
compressor
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-421
P0AA6-612
Hybrid Battery
Voltage System
Isolation Fault
Insulation
resistance of
HV battery,
battery ECU,
system main
relay, or system
main resistor is
low
- HV battery
assembly
- Battery ECU
- System main
relay
- System main
resistor
- Main battery
cable
- No. 2 main
battery cable
- Battery plug
- No. 2 frame
wire
- Junction block
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-421
P0AA6-613
Hybrid Battery
Voltage System
Isolation Fault
Insulation
resistance of
HV transaxle or
motor and
generator
inverters is low
- HV transaxle
assembly
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-421
HV
Master
Warning Light
MIL
Memory
See page
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Master
Warning Light
MIL
Memory
HV–79
DTC No.
Detection Item
DTC Detection
Condition
Trouble Area
See page
P0AA6-614
Hybrid Battery
Voltage System
Isolation Fault
Insulation
resistance of
motor and
generator
inverters, A/C
inverter, system
main relay,
system main
resistor, or
frame wire is
low
- Frame wire
- System main
relay
- System main
resistor
- HV battery
assembly
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
- Main battery
cable
- No. 2 main
battery cable
- Battery plug
- No. 2 frame
wire
- Junction block
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-421
P0ADB-227
Hybrid Battery
Positive
Contactor
Control Circuit
Low
GND short in
No. 2 system
main relay
circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- No. 2 system
main relay
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-439
P0ADC-226
Hybrid Battery
Positive
Contactor
Control Circuit
High
Open or +B
short in No. 2
system main
relay circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- No. 2 system
main relay
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-439
P0ADF-229
Hybrid Battery
Negative
Contactor
Control Circuit
Low
GND short in
No. 3 system
main relay
circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- No. 3 system
main relay
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-441
P0AE0-228
Hybrid Battery
Negative
Contactor
Control Circuit
High
Open or +B
short in No. 3
system main
relay circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- No. 3 system
main relay
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-441
P0AE6-225
Hybrid Battery
Precharge
Contactor
Control Circuit
Low
GND short in
No. 1 system
main relay
circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- No. 1 system
main relay
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-444
P0AE7-224
Hybrid Battery
Precharge
Contactor
Control Circuit
High
Open or +B
short in No. 1
system main
relay circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- No. 1 system
main relay
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-444
HV
HV–80
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC No.
Detection Item
DTC Detection
Condition
Trouble Area
P0AEE-276
Motor Inverter
Temperature
Sensor "A"
Circuit Range /
Performance
Sudden change
in motor
inverter
temperature
sensor output
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter
cooling system
- Water pump
w/ motor and
bracket
assembly
- Cooling fan
motor
- No. 2 Cooling
fan motor
- w/ Converter
inverter
assembly
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-448
P0AEE-277
Motor Inverter
Temperature
Sensor "A"
Circuit Range /
Performance
Motor inverter
temperature
sensor output
deviation
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter
cooling system
- Water pump
w/ motor and
bracket
assembly
- Cooling fan
motor
- No. 2 Cooling
fan motor
- w/ Converter
inverter
assembly
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-448
P0AEF-275
Drive Motor
Inverter
Temperature
Sensor "A"
Circuit Low
Open or GND
short in motor
inverter
temperature
sensor circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- w/ Converter
inverter
assembly
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-453
P0AF0-274
Drive Motor
Inverter
Temperature
Sensor "A"
Circuit High
+B short in
monitor inverter
temperature
sensor circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- w/ Converter
inverter
assembly
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-453
P2120-111
Throttle / Pedal
Position Sensor
/ Switch "D"
Circuit
Accelerator
pedal position
main sensor
value does not
change while
its sub sensor
value changes
- Accelerator
pedal rod
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-458
P2121-106
Throttle / Pedal
Position Sensor
/ Switch "D"
Circuit Range /
Performance
Internal error of
accelerator
pedal position
main sensor
- Accelerator
pedal rod
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-458
P2121-114
Throttle / Pedal
Position Sensor
/ Switch "D"
Circuit Range /
Performance
Accelerator
pedal not
smoothly
returning to its
original position
- Accelerator
pedal rod
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-458
HV
Master
Warning Light
MIL
Memory
See page
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Trouble Area
Master
Warning Light
MIL
Memory
HV–81
DTC No.
Detection Item
DTC Detection
Condition
See page
P2122-104
Throttle / Pedal
Position Sensor
/ Switch "D"
Circuit Low
Input
Open or GND
short in
accelerator
pedal position
main sensor
circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Accelerator
pedal rod
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-460
P2123-105
Throttle / Pedal
Position Sensor
/ Switch "D"
Circuit High
Input
+B short in
accelerator
pedal position
main sensor
circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Accelerator
pedal rod
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-460
P2125-112
Throttle / Pedal
Position Sensor
/ Switch "E"
Circuit
Accelerator
pedal position
sub sensor
value does not
change while
its main sensor
value changes
- Accelerator
pedal rod
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-458
P2126-109
Throttle / Pedal
Position Sensor
/ Switch "E"
Circuit Range /
Performance
Internal error of
accelerator
pedal position
sub sensor
- Accelerator
pedal rod
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-458
P2127-107
Throttle / Pedal
Position Sensor
/ Switch "E"
Circuit Low
Input
Open or GND
short in
accelerator
pedal position
sub sensor
circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Accelerator
pedal rod
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-460
P2128-108
Throttle / Pedal
Position Sensor
/ Switch "E"
Circuit High
Input
+B short in
accelerator
pedal position
sub sensor
circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Accelerator
pedal rod
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-460
P2138-110
Throttle / Pedal
Position Sensor
/ Switch "D" /
"E" Voltage
Correlation
Difference
between main
sensor value
and sub sensor
value is large
- Accelerator
pedal rod
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-458
P3000-123
HV Battery
Malfunction
Abnormal
signal input
from battery
ECU (HV
battery system
malfunction)
- HV battery
system
- Battery ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-466
P3000-125
HV Battery
Malfunction
Abnormal
signal input
from battery
ECU (High
voltage fuse
blown out)
- HV battery
system
- Battery ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-466
P3000-388
HV Battery
Malfunction
Abnormal
signal input
from battery
ECU
(discharge
inhibition
control
malfunction)
- HV control
system
- Fuel shortage
- HV battery
assembly
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-467
HV
HV–82
DTC No.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Detection Item
DTC Detection
Condition
P3000-389
HV Battery
Malfunction
Abnormal
signal input
from battery
ECU (drop of
high voltage)
- HV control
system
- HV battery
assembly
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-469
P3000-603
HV Battery
Malfunction
Abnormal
signal input
from battery
ECU (HV
battery cooling
system
malfunction)
- HV battery
system
- Battery ECU
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-466
P3004-131
Power Cable
Malfunction
High voltage
fuse has blown
out, service
plug grip is
disconnected
or limiter
resistance is
cut off
- HV battery
system
- System main
resistor
- No. 1 system
main relay
- No. 3 system
main relay
- Main battery
cable
- No. 2 main
battery cable
- Frame wire
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-470
P3004-132
Power Cable
Malfunction
Inverter voltage
sensor
malfunction, or
limiter
resistance
increases
- HV battery
system
- System main
resistor
- No. 1 system
main relay
- No. 3 system
main relay
- Main battery
cable
- No. 2 main
battery cable
- Frame wire
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-477
P3004-133
Power Cable
Malfunction
Abnormal
signal input
from battery
ECU
- HV battery
system
- Battery ECU
-
-
DTC stored
HV-483
P3102-524
Transmission
Control ECU
Malfunction
BEAN
communication
problem of
transmission
control ECU
assembly
- Wire harness
or connector
- Transmission
control ECU
assembly
- HV control
ECU
- Power source
control ECU
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-484
HV
Trouble Area
Master
Warning Light
MIL
Memory
See page
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC No.
HV–83
Detection Item
DTC Detection
Condition
Trouble Area
P3102-525
Transmission
Control ECU
Malfunction
Transmission
control ECU IG
OFF command
malfunction
- Wire harness
or connector
- Transmission
control ECU
assembly
- HV control
ECU
- Power source
control ECU
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-484
P3102-581
Transmission
Control ECU
Malfunction
Transmission
control ECU
malfunction
- Wire harness
or connector
- Transmission
control ECU
assembly
- HV control
ECU
- Power source
control ECU
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-484
P3102-582
Transmission
Control ECU
Malfunction
P position
(PPOS) signal
is logically
inconsistent
- Wire harness
or connector
- Transmission
control ECU
assembly
- HV control
ECU
- Power source
control ECU
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-484
P3102-597
Transmission
Control ECU
Malfunction
GND short in P
position
(PPOS) signal
circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Transmission
control ECU
assembly
- HV control
ECU
- Power source
control ECU
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-484
P3102-598
Transmission
Control ECU
Malfunction
+B short in P
position
(PPOS) signal
circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Transmission
control ECU
assembly
- HV control
ECU
- Power source
control ECU
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-484
P3102-599
Transmission
Control ECU
Malfunction
P position
(PPOS) signal
malfunction
(output pulse is
abnormal)
- Wire harness
or connector
- Transmission
control ECU
assembly
- HV control
ECU
- Power source
control ECU
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-484
P3107-213
Airbag ECU
Communication
Circuit
Malfunction
GND short in
communication
circuit between
center airbag
sensor and HV
control ECU
- Wire harness
or connector
- Center airbag
sensor
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-489
Master
Warning Light
MIL
Memory
See page
HV
HV–84
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC No.
Detection Item
DTC Detection
Condition
Trouble Area
P3107-214
Airbag ECU
Communication
Circuit
Malfunction
Open or +B
short in
communication
circuit between
center airbag
sensor and HV
control ECU
- Wire harness
or connector
- Center airbag
sensor
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-489
P3107-215
Airbag ECU
Communication
Circuit
Malfunction
Abnormal
communication
signals
between center
airbag sensor
and HV control
ECU
- Wire harness
or connector
- Center airbag
sensor
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-489
P3108-535
A/C Amplifier
Communication
Circuit
Malfunction
Serial
communication
malfunction
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
-
-
DTC stored
HV-491
P3108-536
A/C Amplifier
Communication
Circuit
Malfunction
A/C inverter
malfunction
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
-
-
DTC stored
HV-491
P3108-537
A/C Amplifier
Communication
Circuit
Malfunction
Air conditioning
amplifier
malfunction
- Air
conditioning
amplifier
-
-
DTC stored
HV-494
P3108-538
A/C Amplifier
Communication
Circuit
Malfunction
Open in STB
signal circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
-
-
DTC stored
HV-491
P3108-594
A/C Amplifier
Communication
Circuit
Malfunction
CAN
communication
malfunction
- CAN
communication
system
-
-
DTC stored
HV-495
P3110-223
IGCT Relay
Malfunction
IGCT relay is
always closed
- Wire harness
or connector
- Integration
relay (IGCT
relay)
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-496
P3110-527
HV Main Relay
Malfunction
IG2 logical
inconsistency
- Wire harness
or connector
- Integration
relay (IG2
relay)
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-496
P3137-348
Collision
Sensor Low
Input
GND short in
No. 1 circuit
breaker sensor
circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- No. 1 circuit
breaker sensor
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-498
P3138-349
Collision
Sensor High
Input
Open or +B
short in No. 1
circuit breaker
sensor circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- No. 1 circuit
breaker sensor
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-498
HV
Master
Warning Light
MIL
Memory
See page
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC No.
Master
Warning Light
MIL
Memory
HV–85
Detection Item
DTC Detection
Condition
Trouble Area
See page
P3221-314
Generator
Inverter
Temperature
Sensor Circuit
Range /
Performance
Sudden change
in generator
inverter
temperature
sensor output
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter
cooling system
- Water pump
with motor
assembly
- Cooling fan
motor
- No. 2 cooling
fan motor
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-500
P3221-315
Generator
Inverter
Temperature
Sensor Circuit
Range /
Performance
Generator
inverter
temperature
sensor output
deviation
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter
cooling system
- Water pump
with motor
assembly
- Cooling fan
motor
- No. 2 cooling
fan motor
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-500
P3222-313
Generator
Inverter
Temperature
Sensor Circuit
High / Low
Open or GND
short in
generator
inverter
temperature
sensor circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-505
P3223-312
Generator
Inverter
Temperature
Sensor Circuit
High
+B short in
generator
inverter
temperature
sensor circuit
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
- HV control
ECU
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-505
P3226-562
DC/DC Boost
Converter
Temperature
Sensor
Sudden change
in boost
converter
temperature
sensor output
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter
cooling system
- Water pump
with motor
assembly
- Cooling fan
motor
- No. 2 cooling
fan motor
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-510
HV
HV–86
DTC No.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Detection Item
DTC Detection
Condition
Trouble Area
P3226-563
DC/DC Boost
Converter
Temperature
Sensor
Boost converter
temperature
sensor output
deviation
- Wire harness
or connector
- Inverter
cooling system
- Water pump
with motor
assembly
- Cooling fan
motor
- No. 2 cooling
fan motor
- Inverter with
converter
assembly
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-510
U0100-211
Lost
Communication
with ECM /
PCM "A"
CAN
communication
problem
between ECM
and HV control
ECU (no signal
input)
- CAN
communication
system
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-515
U0100-212
Lost
Communication
with ECM /
PCM "A"
CAN
communication
problem
between ECM
and HV control
ECU
(transmission
error)
- CAN
communication
system
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-515
U0100-530
Lost
Communication
with ECM /
PCM "A"
CAN
communication
problem
between ECM
and HV control
ECU (CAN
communication
system
malfunction)
- CAN
communication
system
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-515
U0111-208
Lost
Communication
with Battery
Energy Control
Module "A"
CAN
communication
problem
between
battery ECU
and HV control
ECU (no signal
input)
- CAN
communication
system
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-515
U0111-531
Lost
Communication
with Battery
Energy Control
Module "A"
CAN
communication
problem
between
battery ECU
and HV control
ECU (CAN
communication
system
malfunction)
- CAN
communication
system
Comes on
Comes on
DTC stored
HV-515
U0129-220
Lost
Communication
with Brake
System Control
Module
CAN
communication
problem
between skid
control ECU
and HV control
ECU (no signal
input)
- CAN
communication
system
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-515
HV
Master
Warning Light
MIL
Memory
See page
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Master
Warning Light
MIL
Memory
HV–87
DTC No.
Detection Item
DTC Detection
Condition
Trouble Area
See page
U0129-222
Lost
Communication
with Brake
System Control
Module
CAN
communication
problem
between skid
control ECU
and HV control
ECU (CAN
communication
system
malfunction)
- CAN
communication
system
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-515
U0129-528
Lost
Communication
with Brake
System Control
Module
CAN
communication
problem
between skid
control ECU
and HV control
ECU
(transmission
error)
- CAN
communication
system
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-515
U0129-529
Lost
Communication
with Brake
System Control
Module
CAN
communication
problem
between skid
control ECU
and HV control
ECU
(regenerative
torque
malfunction)
- CAN
communication
system
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-515
U0131-433
Lost
Communication
with Power
Steering
Control Module
CAN
communication
problem
between power
steering ECU
and HV control
ECU (no signal
input)
- CAN
communication
system
-
-
DTC stored
HV-515
U0131-434
Lost
Communication
with Power
Steering
Control Module
CAN
communication
problem
between power
steering ECU
and HV control
ECU (CAN
communication
system
malfunction)
- CAN
communication
system
-
-
DTC stored
HV-515
U0146-435
Lost
Communication
with Gateway
"A"
CAN
communication
problem
between
gateway ECU
and HV control
ECU (no signal
input)
- CAN
communication
system
Comes on
-
DTC stored
HV-515
HV
HV–88
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
INFORMATION / FREEZE FRAME DATA
1.
FREEZE FRAME DATA
HINT:
The freeze frame data records the driving condition
when the DTC was set. It is used for estimating or
simulating the condition of the vehicle when the
malfunction occurred. To check the details of the hybrid
vehicle control system, check the detailed information for
the DTC (Information).
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/
MOBD / HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Select a DTC in order to display its freeze frame
data.
(f) Check the freeze frame data of the DTC that has
been detected.
(g) Check information of the DTC (see below).
Freeze frame data:
HV
Intelligent Tester Display
Measurement Item / Range (Display)
Suspected Vehicle Status When
Malfunction Occurs
FREEZE DTC
DTC corresponding to displayed freeze frame
data
-
COOLANT TEMP
Engine coolant temperature /
Min.: -40°C, Max.: 140°C
Cold or warm engine
VEHICLE SPD
Vehicle speed /
Min.: 0 km/h, Max.: 255 km/h
Stopped, or driving (low, medium, and high
speeds)
ENG RUN TIME
Elapsed time after starting engine /
Min.: 0 s, Max.: 65,535 s
Elapsed time from engine start
+B
Auxiliary battery voltage /
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 65.535 V
Condition of auxiliary battery
ACCEL POS #1
No. 1 accelerator pedal position sensor /
Min.: 0%, Max.: 100%
Idling, accelerating, or decelerating
ACCEL POS #2
No. 2 accelerator pedal position sensor /
Min.: 0%, Max.: 100%
Idling, accelerating or decelerating (For
comparison with above to detect failure of No.
1 accelerator pedal position sensor)
AMBIENT TEMP
Ambient air temperature /
Min.: -40°C, Max.: 215°C
Ambient air temperature
INTAKE AIR TEMP
Intake air temperature /
Min.: -40°C, Max.: 140°C
Ambient air temperature
DTC CLEAR WARM
The number of times engine is warmed up
after clearing DTCs /
Min.: 0, Max.: 255
Frequency of the malfunction recurrence after
clearing DTCs
DTC CLEAR RUN
Drive distance after clearing DTCs /
Min.: 0 km, Max.: 65,535 km
Frequency of the malfunction recurrence after
clearing DTCs
DTC CLEAR MIN
Elapsed time after clearing DTCs /
Min.: 0 min, Max.: 65,535 min
Frequency of the malfunction recurrence after
clearing DTCs
ECU TYPE
Type of ECU
-
INFORMATION 1 to 5
Information code
-
2.
INFORMATION
HINT:
Similar to freeze frame data, information records
operating condition of the HV system and components at
the time of detection of a DTC.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–89
(a) Select one which has an INF code from among
INFORMATION 1 to 5.
(b) Check the information of the DTC.
Information:
Intelligent Tester Display
Measurement Item / Range (Display)
Suspected Vehicle Status When
Malfunction Occurs
INFORMATION N
Information code
Indication of system with malfunction
MG1 REV
MG1 revolution /
Min.: -16,384 rpm, Max.: 16,256 rpm
MG1 speed
• Forward rotation appears as "+"
• Backward rotation appears as "-"
MG2 REV
MG2 revolution /
Min.: -16,384 rpm, Max.: 16,256 rpm
MG2 speed (proportionate to vehicle speed)
• Forward rotation appears as "+"
• Backward rotation appears as "-"
Moving direction of vehicle
• Forward direction appears as "+"
• Backward direction appears as "-"
MG1 TORQ
MG1 torque /
Min.: -512 Nm, Max.: 508 Nm
When MG1 rotation in + direction:
• Torque appears as "+" while MG1
discharges
• Torque appears as "-" while MG1 charges
When MG1 rotation in - direction:
• Torque appears as "-" while MG1
discharges
• Torque appears as "+" while MG1
charges
MG2 TORQ
MG2 torque /
Min.: -512 Nm, Max.: 508 Nm
When MG2 rotation in + direction:
• Torque appears as "+" while MG2
discharges
• Torque appears as "-" while MG2 charges
When MG2 rotation in - direction:
• Torque appears as "-" while MG2
discharges
• Torque appears as "+" while MG2
charges
INVERT TEMP-MG1
MG1 inverter temperature /
Min.: -50°C, Max.: 205°C
MG1 inverter temperature
INVERT TEMP-MG2
MG2 inverter temperature /
Min.: -50°C, Max.: 205°C
MG2 inverter temperature
MG2 TEMP (No2)
Transaxle fluid temperature /
Min.: -50°C, Max.: 205°C
Transaxle fluid temperature
MG2 TEMP (No1)
MG2 temperature /
Min.: -50°C, Max.: 205°C
MG2 temperature
POWER RQST
Request engine power /
Min.: 0 W, Max.: 255 kW
Engine power output requested to ECM
ENGINE SPD
Engine speed /
Min.: 0 rpm, Max.: 16,320 rpm
Engine speed
MCYL CTRL POWER
Master cylinder control torque /
Min.: -512 Nm, Max.: 508 Nm
Brake force requested by driver
SOC
Battery state of charge /
Min.: 0%, Max.: 100%
State of charge of HV battery
WOUT CTRL POWER
Power value discharge control /
Min.: 0 W, Max.: 81,600 W
Discharge amount of HV battery
WIN CTRL POWER
Power value charge control /
Min.: -40,800 W, Max.: 0 W
Charge amount of HV battery
DRIVE CONDITION
Drive condition ID
• Engine stopped: 0
• Engine about to be stopped: 1
• Engine about to be started: 2
• Engine operated or operating: 3
• Generating or loading movement: 4
• Revving up with P position: 6
Engine operating condition
PWR RESOURCE VB
HV battery voltage /
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 510 V
HV battery voltage
HV
HV–90
HV
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Intelligent Tester Display
Measurement Item / Range (Display)
Suspected Vehicle Status When
Malfunction Occurs
PWR RESOURCE IB
HV battery current /
Min.: -256 A, Max.: 254 A
Charging / discharging state of HV battery
• Discharging amperage indicated by a
positive value
• Charging amperage indicated by a
negative value
SHIFT POSITION
Shift position (P, R, N, D or B position)
P: 0, R: 1, N: 2, D: 3, B: 4
Shift position
ACCEL SENSOR M
Accelerator pedal position sensor main /
Min.: 0%, Max.: 100%
Idling, accelerating, or decelerating
AUX. BATT V
Auxiliary battery voltage /
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 20 V
State of auxiliary battery
CONVERTER TEMP
Boost converter temperature /
Min.: -50°C, Max.: 205°C
Boost converter temperature
VL
High voltage before it is boosted /
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 510 V
High voltage level before it is boosted
VH
High voltage after it is boosted /
Min.: 0 V, Max.: 765 V
High voltage level after it is boosted
IG ON TIME
The time after power switch ON (IG) /
Min.: 0 min, Max.: 255 min
Time elapsed with power switch ON (IG)
VEHICLE SPD-MAX
Maximum vehicle speed /
Min.: -256 km/h, Max.: 254 km/h
Maximum vehicle speed
A/C CONSMPT PWR
A/C consumption power /
Min.: 0 kW, Max.: 5 kW
A/C load
ENG STOP RQST
Engine stop request /
NO or YES
Presence of engine stop request
IDLING REQUEST
Engine idling request /
NO or YES
Presence of idle stop request
ENGINE FUEL CUT
Engine fuel cut request /
NO or YES
Presence of fuel cut request
HV BATT CH RQST
HV battery charging request /
NO or YES
Presence of HV battery charging request
ENG WARM UP RQT
Engine warming up request /
NO or YES
Presence of engine warm-up request
STOP SW COND
Stop light switch ON condition /
NO or YES
Brake pedal depressed or released
CRUISE CONTROL
Cruise control active condition /
NO or YES
Operation under cruise control ON or OFF
EXCLUSIVE INFO 1 to 7
Exclusive information (in form of numerical
data)
Exclusive Information linked to Information
OCCURRENCE ORDER
Occurrence sequence of information
Occurrence sequence of information
INVT TMP-MG1 IG
MG1 inverter temperature after power switch
ON (IG) /
Min.: -50°C, Max.: 205°C
MG1 inverter temperature soon after power
switch ON (IG)
INVT TMP-MG2 IG
MG2 inverter temperature after power switch
ON (IG) /
Min.: -50°C, Max.: 205°C
MG2 inverter temperature soon after power
switch ON (IG)
MG2 TEMP IG
MG2 temperature after power switch ON (IG)
/
Min.: -50°C, Max.: 205°C
MG2 temperature soon after power switch ON
(IG)
CONVRTR TEMP IG
Boost converter temperature after power
switch ON (IG) /
Min.: -50°C, Max.: 205°C
Boost converter temperature soon after power
switch ON (IG)
SOC IG
Battery state of charge after power switch ON
(IG) /
Min.: 0%, Max.: 100%
Battery state of charge soon after power
switch ON (IG)
INVT TMP-MG1MAX
MG1 inverter maximum temperature /
Min.: -50°C, Max.: 205°C
Overheating state of MG1 inverter
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Intelligent Tester Display
Measurement Item / Range (Display)
Suspected Vehicle Status When
Malfunction Occurs
INVT TMP-MG2MAX
MG2 inverter maximum temperature /
Min.: -50°C, Max.: 205°C
Overheating state of MG2 inverter
MG2 TEMP MAX
MG2 maximum temperature /
Min.: -50°C, Max.: 205°C
Overheating state of MG2
CONVRTR TMP MAX
Boost converter maximum temperature /
Min.: -50°C, Max.: 205°C
Overheating state of boost converter
SOC MAX
Maximum status of charge /
Min.: 0%, Max.: 100%
Over-charging of HV battery
SOC MIN
Minimum status of charge /
Min.: 0%, Max.: 100%
Over-discharging of HV battery
HV–91
HV
HV–92
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
OPERATION HISTORY DATA
1.
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Intelligent Tester
CAN VIM
DLC3
OPERATION HISTORY DATA
HINT:
The operation history data records the special operations
performed by the driver and the number of abnormal
conditions that have been input into the HV control ECU.
A082795E01
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/
MOBD / HV ECU / DATA LIST.
(e) Select the menu to view the number of special
operations or controls that have been effected.
HINT:
• LATEST OPER: Among the past occurrences, the number
of special operations or controls that have been effected
during the most recent 1 trip detection.
• LATEST TRIP: The number of trips after the occurrence of
LATEST OPER.
• BEF LATEST OPER: The number of occurrences 1
previously from the LATEST OPER.
• BEF LATEST TRIP: The number of trips after the
occurrence of BEF LATEST OPER.
Operation history data:
Intelligent Tester Display
HV
Count Condition
SHIFT BEF READY
Shift lever moved with READY light blinking
N RANGE CTRL 2
N position control effected due to frequent shifting operation
STEP ACCEL IN N
Accelerator pedal depressed in N position
AUX. BATT LOW
Auxiliary battery voltage below 9.5 V
HV INTERMITTENT
Instantaneous open at IGSW terminal of HV control ECU
MG2 (NO1) TEMP HI
Motor temperature rose above 174°C (345°F)
MG2 (NO2) TEMP HI
Transaxle fluid temperature rose above 162°C (324°F)
MG2 INV TEMP HI
Motor inverter temperature rose above 111°C (232°F)
MG1 INV TEMP HI
Generator inverter temperature rose above 111°C (232°F)
MAIN BATT LOW
Battery state of charge dropped below 30%
RESIST OVR HEAT
Limit resistor forecast temperature rose above 120°C (248°F)
COOLANT HEAT
Inverter coolant forecast temperature rose above 65°C (149°F)
CONVERTER HEAT
Boost converter temperature rose above 111°C (232°F)
SHIFT P IN RUN
Shifted to P while driving
BKWRD DIR SHIFT
Shifted to R while moving forward or to D or B while moving in reverse
PREVENT STAYING
Engine speed stays in resonance frequency band
HV–93
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Crankshaft Position Sensor "A" Circuit Range /
Performance
DTC
P0336-137
DTC
P0340-532 Camshaft Position Sensor "A" Circuit
DESCRIPTION
If there is any malfunction in the communication values or pulse inputs, the HV control ECU detects it by
comparing the following three speeds: the engine speed transmitted by the ECM via CAN (Controller Area
Network) communication, the engine speed obtained through pulse inputs, and the engine speed
calculated from the MG1 and MG2 speeds.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0336
137
Engine speed sensor deviation
malfunction (CAN
communication)
•
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Crankshaft position sensor
Camshaft position sensor
HV control ECU
P0340
532
Engine speed sensor deviation
malfunction (pulse signal)
•
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Crankshaft position sensor
Camshaft position sensor
HV control ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
HV Control ECU
ECM
1
NEO E7
LG
12
H16 NEO
HV
2
GO E7
Y
13
H16 GO
A014121E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ OUTPUT DTC (ENGINE)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTCs are output.
YES
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
HV–94
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
NO
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the H16 HV control ECU connector.
H16
GO
NEO
HV Control ECU Connector
A065745E34
(b) Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E7
GO
NEO
Specified Condition
NEO (H16-12) - NEO (E7-1)
Below 1 Ω
GO (H16-13) - GO (E7-2)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
ECM Connector
A065744E18
HV
Tester Connection
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
NEO (H16-12) or NEO (E7-1) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
GO (H16-13) or GO (E7-2) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(e) Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
3
INSPECT CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Inspect crankshaft position sensor (see page ES-443).
NG
REPLACE CRANKSHAFT POSITION
SENSOR
OK
4
INSPECT CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Inspect camshaft position sensor (see page ES-440).
NG
REPLACE CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–95
OK
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
HV
HV–96
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0338-600
Crankshaft Position Sensor "A" Circuit High
Input
DTC
P0343-601
Camshaft Position Sensor "A" Circuit High
Input
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0336 (INF 137) (see page HV-91).
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0338
600
NEO signal circuit malfunction
•
•
Wire harness or connector
HV control ECU
P0343
601
GO signal circuit malfunction
•
•
Wire harness or connector
HV control ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0336 (INF 137) (see page HV-91).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ OUTPUT DTC (ENGINE)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTCs are output
HV
YES
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
NO
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the H16 HV control ECU connector.
H16
GO
NEO
HV Control ECU Connector
A065745E34
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
(b) Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E7
Tester Connection
GO
HV–97
NEO
Specified Condition
NEO (H16-12) - NEO (E7-1)
Below 1 Ω
GO (H16-13) - GO (E7-2)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
ECM Connector
A065744E18
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
NEO (H16-12) or NEO (E7-1) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
GO (H16-13) or GO (E7-2) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(e) Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
HV
HV–98
3
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT OUTPUT WAVEFORM
H16
H14
(a) Inspect the ECM using an oscilloscope.
(1) While the engine is idling, check the waveform
between the terminals of the HV control ECU
connector.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
GO
NEO
GND1
NEO Signal Waveform
NEO (H16-12) - GND1 (H14-1)
Correct waveform appears as shown
GO (H16-13) - GND1 (H14-1)
Correct waveform appears as shown
NG
HV Control ECU Connector
1 V/DIV.
GND
2 msec./DIV.
GO Signal Waveform
HV
Specified Condition
2 V/DIV.
GND
20 msec./DIV.
A133405E02
OK
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
REPLACE ECM
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
HV–99
P0560-117 System Voltage
DESCRIPTION
Since the ECU back-up power source is used for DTCs and freeze frame data memory, the back-up
power source (BATT) continues to be supplied to the HV control ECU even if the power switch is turned
OFF.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0560
117
HV control ECU back-up power
source circuit malfunction
•
•
Wire harness or connector
HEV fuse
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
If 3 or more seconds have elapsed with a voltage of less than 2.5 V at the BATT terminal at the HV control
ECU, the HV control ECU will determine that a malfunction has occurred in the back-up power supply
system, and set a DTC. It will illuminate the MIL the next time the engine is started.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0560 (INF 117): Battery signal malfunction
Required sensor / components
Main: Back-up power source circuit
Sub: Hybrid vehicle control ECU
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
3 seconds
MIL operation
Immediate after next power switch ON (IG)
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
A/D converter
Normal
Auxiliary battery voltage
More than 9.5 V
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Condition (a) or (b) is met
-
(a) Input voltage for BATT signal
Less than 2.5 V
(b) Abnormal flag for SRAM
ON
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Auxiliary battery voltage
Between 9 and 14 V
HV
HV–100
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
HV Control ECU
B
1 BE1
1 B
120 A
MAIN
F15
Fusible
Link Block
Assembly
1 3M
1
Auxiliary
Battery
Y
W
1 3A
60 A
P/I
2
1 3J
1 3K
1
20 A
HEV
J6
J/C
6
H15 BATT
A
A
Y
2
Engine Room Relay Block
A092092E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT FUSE (HEV 20 A)
(a) Remove the HEV fuse from the engine room relay block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the HEV fuse.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
(c) Reinstall the HEV fuse.
Engine Room Relay Block:
NG
HV
Go to step 3
HEV Fuse
A092025E01
OK
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - AUXILIARY
BATTERY)
(a) Disconnect the negative auxiliary battery terminal.
(b) Disconnect the positive auxiliary battery terminal.
Positive Terminal
A081781E01
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–101
(c) Remove the HEV fuse from the engine room relay block.
Engine Room Relay Block:
HEV Fuse
A092026E01
(d) Disconnect the H15 HV control ECU connector.
(e) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
H15
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
BATT (H15-6) - HEV fuse (2)
Below 1 Ω
BATT
HV Control ECU Connector
A065744E17
(f)
NOTICE:
When taking a measurement with a tester, do not
apply excessive force to the tester probe to avoid
damaging the holder.
Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
HEV fuse (1) - Positive auxiliary
battery terminal
Below 1 Ω
NOTICE:
When taking a measurement with a tester, do not
apply excessive force to the tester probe to avoid
damaging the holder.
(g) Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
(h) Reinstall the HEV fuse.
(i) Reconnect the positive auxiliary battery terminal.
(j) Reconnect the negative auxiliary battery terminal.
NG
OK
CHECK AND REPAIR CONNECTOR CONNECTION
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
HV
HV–102
3
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - HEV FUSE)
(a) Disconnect the H15 HV control ECU connector.
H15
BATT
HV Control ECU Connector
A065744E17
(b) Remove the HEV fuse from the engine room relay block.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Engine Room Relay Block:
HEV Fuse
A092026E01
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
BATT (H15-6) or HEV fuse (2) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
NOTICE:
When taking a measurement with a tester, do not
apply excessive force to the tester probe to avoid
damaging the holder.
(d) Reinstall the HEV fuse.
(e) Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
NG
HV
OK
REPLACE FUSE (HEV 20 A)
AFTER REPAIRING OR REPLACING
HARNESS OR CONNECTOR, REPLACE
FUSE (HEV 20 A)
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
HV–103
P0630-804 VIN not Programmed or Mismatch-ECM / PCM
DESCRIPTION
DTC P0630 is set if the Vehicle Identification Number (VIN) is not stored in the HV control ECU or the
input VIN is not accurate. Input the VIN with the intelligent tester (see page HV-22).
DTC No.
P0630
INF No.
804
DTC Detection Condition
•
•
Trouble Area
VIN not stored in HV control ECU
Input VIN in HV control ECU not accurate
HV control ECU
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ CURRENT DTC
NOTICE:
If P0630 is set, the VIN must be input to the HV control
ECU using the intelligent tester. However, all DTCs are
cleared automatically by the tester when inputting the
VIN. If DTCs other than P0630-804 are set, check them
first.
NEXT
2
INPUT VIN WITH INTELLIGENT TESTER
(a) Input the VIN with intelligent tester (see page HV-22).
NOTICE:
Be sure to check the auxiliary battery voltage before
performing VIN writing because VIN writing cannot
be performed if the auxiliary battery voltage is below
10 V.
NEXT
3
READ OUTPUT DTC
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Select the following menu items: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/
MOBD / HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(d) Read output DTC (see page HV-39).
OK:
DTC P0630-804 is not output.
NG
OK
END
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
HV
HV–104
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0705-571 Transmission Range Sensor Circuit
DTC
P0705-572 Transmission Range Sensor Circuit
DTC
P0705-573 Transmission Range Sensor Circuit
DTC
P0705-574 Transmission Range Sensor Circuit
DTC
P0705-575 Transmission Range Sensor Circuit
DTC
P0705-576 Transmission Range Sensor Circuit
DTC
P0705-577 Transmission Range Sensor Circuit
DTC
P0705-578 Transmission Range Sensor Circuit
DTC
P0705-595 Transmission Range Sensor Circuit
DTC
P0705-596 Transmission Range Sensor Circuit
DESCRIPTION
HINT:
• The shift control system is a linkless type that does not use a shift cable.
• The shift and select sensors are a non-contact type.
HV
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–105
The selector lever is a momentary type, which returns to its home position by spring reaction as the
driver's hand is released from the selector lever after shifting. The selector lever contains a shift sensor
and a select sensor to detect the selector lever position (R, N, D or B). Because both sensors are
controlled electrically by Hall elements, they can accurately detect shift positions in a reliable manner.
Both sensors contain two systems of detection circuits, main and sub.
Shift Sensor:
Selector Lever:
Hall IC
Select Sensor
Yoke
Magnet
Select Sensor:
Shift Sensor
Hall IC
Magnet Slider
A087734E01
HV
HV–106
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
The shift sensor outputs voltage, which varies between 0 and 5 V in accordance with the vertical
movement of the selector lever, to the HV control ECU. The HV control ECU interprets low level voltage
input from the shift sensor as the D or B position, middle level voltage as the home or N position, and high
level voltage as the R position.
Shift Sensor Output Voltage (V)
HV Control ECU
Shift Sensor
Hall IC
VCX1
4.0 to 4.8
High
2.5
5V
Middle
Low
0.2 to 1.0
Magnet
VSX1
Operation Range
E2X1
VCX2
7.24 0 7.24
5V
Shift Sensor Rotational Angle (deg)
Home Position
VSX2
Magnet
Hall IC
5V
E2X2
H
R
HV
Shift Sensor
Output Voltage
M
L
0V
N
D
B
A125423E01
HV–107
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
The select sensor outputs voltage, which varies between 0 and 5 V in accordance with the horizontal
movement of the selector lever, to the HV control ECU. The HV control ECU interprets low level voltage
input from the select sensor as the home or B position, and high level voltage as the R, N, or D position.
The HV control ECU determines the position of the selector lever in accordance with the combination of
the signals from the shift sensor and select sensor.
Select Sensor
HV Control ECU
Hall IC
VCX3
VSX3
VCX4
VSX3
Slide
+B
+B
Hall IC
Magnetic Slider
Undetermined
Home or B
R, N or D
Home Position
R
Output
Voltage (V)
4.85
High
3.0
2.0
0.5
Low
Operation Range
N
D
HV
B
H
L
Signal Amount
Home
Position
A125424E01
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0705
571
Open or GND short in shift main
sensor circuit
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Selector lever
HV control ECU
P0705
572
+B short in shift main sensor
circuit
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Selector lever
HV control ECU
P0705
573
Open or GND short in shift sub
sensor circuit
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Selector lever
HV control ECU
P0705
574
+B short in shift sub sensor circuit
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Selector lever
HV control ECU
P0705
575
Open or GND short in select main
sensor circuit
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Selector lever
HV control ECU
HV–108
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0705
576
+B short in select main sensor
circuit
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Selector lever
HV control ECU
P0705
577
Open or GND short in select sub
sensor circuit
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Selector lever
HV control ECU
P0705
578
+B short in select sub sensor
circuit
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Selector lever
HV control ECU
P0705
595
Difference between shift main
sensor value and shift sub sensor
value is large
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Selector lever
HV control ECU
P0705
596
Difference between select main
sensor value and select sub
sensor value is large
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Selector lever
HV control ECU
HINT:
After confirming DTC P0705 (INF 571, 572, 573, or 574), confirm M and S SHIFT SENSOR voltages
using the intelligent tester.
M and S SHIFT SENSOR
HV
R Position
(Main)
Home or N
Position
(Main)
D or B Position
(Main)
R Position
(Sub)
Home or N
Position
(Sub)
D or B Position
(Sub)
Trouble Area
0 to 0.2 V
0 to 0.2 V
0 to 0.2 V
4.0 to 4.8 V
2.0 to 3.0 V
0.2 to 1.0 V
Open in VCX1
circuit
4.0 to 4.8 V
2.0 to 3.0 V
0.2 to 1.0 V
0 to 0.2 V
0 to 0.2 V
0 to 0.2 V
Open in VCX2
circuit
0 to 0.2 V
0 to 0.2 V
0 to 0.2 V
4.0 to 4.8 V
2.0 to 3.0 V
0.2 to 1.0 V
Open or short in
VSX1 circuit
4.0 to 4.8 V
2.0 to 3.0 V
0.2 to 1.0 V
0 to 0.2 V
0 to 0.2 V
0 to 0.2 V
Open or short in
VSX2 circuit
4.8 to 5.0 V
4.8 to 5.0 V
4.8 to 5.0 V
4.0 to 4.8 V
2.0 to 3.0 V
0.2 to 1.0 V
Open in E2X1
circuit
4.0 to 4.8 V
2.0 to 3.0 V
0.2 to 1.0 V
4.8 to 5.0 V
4.8 to 5.0 V
4.8 to 5.0 V
Open in E2X2
circuit
HINT:
After confirming DTC P0705 (INF 575, 576, 577, or 578), confirm SM and SS SHIFT SENSOR voltages
using the intelligent tester.
SM and SS SHIFT SENSOR
R, N or D Position
(Select Main)
Home or B Position
(Select Main)
R, N or D Position
(Select Sub)
Home or B Position
(Select Sub)
Trouble Area
0 to 0.5 V
0 to 0.5 V
3.0 to 4.85 V
0.5 to 2.0 V
Open or GND short in
VCX3 or VSX3 circuit
3.0 to 4.85 V
0.5 to 2.0 V
0 to 0.5 V
0 to 0.5 V
Open or GND short in
VCX4 or VSX4 circuit
HV–109
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
S5
Shift Sensor
HV Control ECU
(Shielded)
VCX1 3
W
17
VCX1
H14
VSX1 1
B
25
VSX1
H14
E2X1 2
R
15
E2X1
H14
VCX2 6
G
16
VCX2
H14
VSX2 4
L
24
VSX2
H14
5V
14
E2X2
Y
H14
No. 1 Center Connector
E2X2 5
S4
Select Sensor
5V
14
4E
W-B
VCX3 3
W
VSX3 5
BR
4
W-B
4H
A
A
J25
J/C
21
VCX3
H14
+B
23
VSX3
H14
W-B
VCX4 6
P
31
VCX4
H14
VSX4 8
SB
30
VSX4
H14
+B
HV
IH
A092093E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (M AND S SHIFT SENSOR)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DATA LIST.
(e) Read the M and S SHIFT SENSOR voltage values.
Result:
Shift Position
M Shift Sensor
S Shift Sensor
R position
4.0 to 4.8 V
4.0 to 4.8 V
HV–110
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Shift Position
M Shift Sensor
S Shift Sensor
Home or N position
2.0 to 3.0 V
2.0 to 3.0 V
D or B position
0.2 to 1.0 V
0.2 to 1.0 V
OK
Go to step 4
NG
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - SHIFT
SENSOR)
(a) Disconnect the H14 HV control ECU connector.
H14
VCX2
VCX1
HV Control
VSX1
ECU Connector
VSX2
E2X2
E2X1
A065748E31
Wire Harness Side:
S5
VSX1
VCX2
E2X2
VSX2
VCX1
Shift Sensor Connector
E2X1
HV
(b) Disconnect the S5 shift sensor connector.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the HV
control ECU connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VCX1 (H14-17) - Body ground
Below 1 V
VSX1 (H14-25) - Body ground
Below 1 V
E2X1 (H14-15) - Body ground
Below 1 V
A092027E01
VCX2 (H14-16) - Body ground
Below 1 V
VSX2 (H14-24) - Body ground
Below 1 V
E2X2 (H14-14) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(e) Turn the power switch OFF.
(f) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VCX1 (H14-17) - VCX1 (S5-3)
Below 1 Ω
VSX1 (H14-25) - VSX1 (S5-1)
Below 1 Ω
E2X1 (H14-15) - E2X1 (S5-2)
Below 1 Ω
VCX2 (H14-16) - VCX2 (S5-6)
Below 1 Ω
VSX2 (H14-24) - VSX2 (S5-4)
Below 1 Ω
E2X2 (H14-14) - E2X2 (S5-5)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VCX1 (H14-17) or VCX1 (S5-3) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
VSX1 (H14-25) or VSX1 (S5-1) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E2X1 (H14-15) or E2X1 (S5-2) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
VCX2 (H14-16) or VCX2 (S5-6) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
VSX2 (H14-24) or VSX2 (S5-4) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
E2X2 (H14-14) or E2X2 (S5-5) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
HV–111
(g) Reconnect the shift sensor connector.
(h) Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
3
CHECK HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU (VCX1 AND VCX2 VOLTAGE)
(a) Disconnect the S5 shift sensor connector.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the shift
sensor connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side:
S5
E2X1
VCX2
E2X2
VCX1
Shift Sensor Connector
A092027E02
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VCX1 (S5-3) - E2X1 (S5-2)
4.5 to 5.5 V
VCX2 (S5-6) - E2X2 (S5-5)
4.5 to 5.5 V
(d) Reconnect the shift sensor connector.
OK
Go to step 7
NG
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
4
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (SM AND SS SHIFT SENSOR)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DATA LIST.
(e) Read the SM and SS SHIFT SENSOR voltage values.
Result:
Shift Position
SM Shift Sensor
SS Shift Sensor
R, N or D position
3.0 to 4.85 V
3.0 to 4.85 V
Home or B position
0.5 to 2.0 V
0.5 to 2.0 V
OK
Go to step 7
HV
HV–112
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
NG
5
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - SELECT
SENSOR)
(a) Disconnect the H14 HV control ECU connector.
H14
VSX3
VCX4
VCX3
VSX4
HV Control ECU Connector
A065748E32
(b) Disconnect the S4 select sensor connector.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the HV
control ECU connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side:
S4
VSX4
VCX3
VSX3 VCX4
Select Sensor Connector
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VCX3 (H14-21) - Body ground
Below 1 V
VVSX3 (H14-23) - Body ground
Below 1 V
VCX4 (H14-31) - Body ground
Below 1 V
VSX4 (H14-30) - Body ground
Below 1 V
A092028E01
HV
(e) Turn the power switch OFF.
(f) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VCX3 (H14-21) - VCX3 (S4-3)
Below 1 Ω
VSX3 (H14-23) - VSX3 (S4-5)
Below 1 Ω
VCX4 (H14-31) - VCX4 (S4-6)
Below 1 Ω
VSX4 (H14-30) - VSX4 (S4-8)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VCX3 (H14-21) or VCX3 (S4-3) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
VSX3 (H14-23) or VSX3 (S4-5) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
VCX4 (H14-31) or VCX4 (S4-6) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
VSX4 (H14-30) or VSX4 (S4-8) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(g) Reconnect the select sensor connector.
(h) Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–113
OK
6
INSPECT HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU (VCX3 AND VCX4 VOLTAGE)
(a) Disconnect the S4 select sensor connector.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the select
sensor connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side:
S4
VCX4
VCX3
Select Sensor Connector
A092028E02
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VCX3 (S4-3) - Body ground
9 to 14 V
VCX4 (S4-6) - Body ground
9 to 14 V
(d) Reconnect the select sensor connector.
NG
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
OK
7
REPLACE SELECTOR LEVER
GO
8
READ OUTPUT DTC (DTC P0705 IS NOT OUTPUT AGAIN)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CLEAR CODES.
(e) Perform a simulation test.
(f) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(g) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTC P0705 is not output again
YES
NO
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
SYSTEM IS OK
HV
HV–114
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0851-579 Park / Neutral Switch Input Circuit Low
DTC
P0852-580 Park / Neutral Switch Input Circuit High
DESCRIPTION
Instead of having a parking position as one of the positions of the conventional shift lever, a P position
switch is provided independently in the upper area of the selector lever. The switch is based on a
momentary type operation mode, in which the button does not lock mechanically.
The P position switch contains resistors R1 and R2. When the P position switch is not pressed, the switch
provides a combined resistance of R1 and R2; and when the P position switch is pressed, the switch
provides only the resistance of R1. The voltage at the P1 terminal of the HV control ECU varies with the
changes in the resistance of the switch. The HV control ECU determines the P position switch operation
intended by the driver according to this resistance signal.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0851
579
GND short in P position switch
circuit
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
P position switch
HV control ECU
P0852
580
Open or +B short in P position
switch circuit
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
P position switch
HV control ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
M11
P Position Switch
Y
J24
J/C
A
HV
3
W-B
4
R1
A
R2
W-B
W-B
IH
HV Control ECU
6 5L
6 5A
No. 2
Center
Connector
No. 2
Center
Connector
Y
17
H15 P1
9 IA2
L
1 5A 8 5H
A092094E01
HV–115
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT P POSITION SWITCH
(a) Remove the P position switch.
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the P
position switch connector.
Standard resistance
Component Side:
M11
E
S
P Position Switch
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
S (M11-4) - E (M11-3)
Keep switch pressed
680 Ω
S (M11-4) - E (M11-3)
Release switch
4,580 Ω
(c) Reinstall the P position switch.
A092029E01
NG
REPLACE P POSITION SWITCH
OK
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - P POSITION
SWITCH)
(a) Disconnect the H15 HV control ECU connector.
H15
P1
HV Control ECU Connector
HV
A065744E33
(b) Disconnect the M11 P position switch connector.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Measure the voltage between the terminal of the HV
control ECU connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side:
S
M11
P Position Switch Connector
A092061E01
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
P1 (H15-17) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(e) Turn the power switch OFF.
(f) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
P1 (H15-17) - S (M11-4)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
P1 (H15-17) or S (M11-4) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(g) Reconnect the P position switch connector.
(h) Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
HV–116
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (P POSITION SWITCH - BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the M11 P position switch connector.
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminal of the P
position switch connector and body ground.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Wire Harness Side:
E
M11
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
E (M11-3) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
(c) Reconnect the P position switch connector.
P Position Switch Connector
A092061E02
NG
OK
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
HV
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A08264
HV–117
DC / DC Converter Status Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The HV Control ECU monitors the DC / DC converter circuit status via the NODD terminal. If the ECU
detects an internal circuit malfunction in the converter and stops converter operation with its fail-safe
function, causing the auxiliary battery voltage to drop below 11 V, the ECU outputs DTC P0A08 (INF 264).
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A08
264
All conditions below are detected
• DC / DC converter internal
circuit malfunction is detected
• DC / DC converter enters failsafe mode
• Auxiliary battery voltage
drops below 11 V
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Auxiliary battery
Fusible link block assembly
Fuse (for 12 V electrical
equipment)
Engine room relay block
Inverter cooling hose
Water pump with motor
assembly
Cooling fan motor
No. 2 cooling fan motor
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly (DC / DC
converter)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0A09 (INF265) (see page HV-125).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Clear the DTC(s) (see page HV-39).
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and turn the intelligent
tester ON.
(d) Read DTC(s).
Result:
Result
Proceed to
One or more of following DTCs is output:
P0A94, P0AA1, P0AA4, P0AA6, P0AE0, P0AE6, P0AE7, P0ADB,
P0ADF, P3000, P3004, P3110
A
P0A08 is output
B
A
GO TO DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE
CHART
B
2
CHECK CABLE CONNECTION FROM AUXILIARY BATTERY TERMINAL
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Check the auxiliary battery (12 V) cable connections at
places listed below:
• The battery positive and negative terminals are not
loose.
HV
HV–118
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
• The body ground of the battery negative cable is not
loose.
• The FL block nut is not loose.
OK:
They are not loose.
NG
CONNECT OR INSTALL SECURELY
OK
3
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS (FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK ASSEMBLY)
(a) Check that the F15 and F16 connectors are securely
connected to the fusible link block assembly.
OK:
Connectors are connected securely.
Fusible Link Block Assembly
F16
OK
Go to step 5
F15
HV
A125632E01
NG
4
CHECK CONNECTOR (FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK ASSEMBLY)
(a) Check that the F15 and F16 connector terminals do not
have burnout.
OK:
There is no burnout.
NG
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE CONNECTOR
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
5
HV–119
INSPECT FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK ASSEMBLY
(a) Measure the resistance between the F15 fusible link
block assembly and body ground.
Standard resistance
Fusible Link Block Assembly
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
F15-1 Body ground
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, proceed to NG-A.
(b) Measure the resistance between the F16 fusible link
block assembly and body ground.
Standard resistance
F16
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
F16-1 Body ground
Below 1 Ω
F16-2 Body ground
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, proceed to NG-B.
F15
NG-A
REPAIR OR REPLACE FUSIBLE LINK
BLOCK ASSEMBLY
NG-B
REPAIR FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK ASSEMBLY
AND REPLACE DC / DC FUSE
A125427E01
OK
6
CHECK INSTALLATION CONDITION OF DC / DC FUSE (ENGINE ROOM JUNCTION
BLOCK)
(a) Check the installation condition of the DC / DC fuse.
OK:
No bolts or nuts are loose.
Engine Room
Junction Block
NG
Bolt
Nut
A125633E01
TIGHTEN BOLT OR NUT
HV
HV–120
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
OK
7
CHECK FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK ASSEMBLY (100A DC / DC-S)
(a) Remove the DC / DC-S fuse from the fusible link block
assembly.
(b) Measure the resistance of the fuse.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK
ASSEMBLY
OK
8
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS (HV CONTROL ECU)
H17
H16
H15
H14
(a) Check that the H14, H15, H16 and H17 ECU connectors
are securely connected.
OK:
Connectors are connected securely.
NG
CONNECT SECURELY
HV Control ECU Connector
A093719E06
HV
OK
9
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS (INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY)
CAUTION:
Inverter with converter assembly:
Be sure to wear insulated gloves.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HV-1).
CAUTION:
Keep the removed service plug grip in your pocket
to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the vehicle.
NOTICE:
After removing the service plug grip, do not operate
the power switch as it may damage the hybrid
vehicle control ECU.
(c) Leave the vehicle as is for 5 minutes.
HINT:
It takes 5 minutes for the high voltage condenser in the
inverter to discharge its electricity.
(d) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–121
(e) Remove the 5 bolts to disconnect the MG2 power cable.
MG2 Power Cable
I14
A083600E01
(f)
Remove the 5 bolts to disconnect the MG1 power cable.
MG1 Power Cable
I15
A083601E01
(g) Check the connection condition of the C5 connector.
OK:
Connector has been connected securely.
1 2 3
4 5 6
NG
CONNECT SECURELY
C5
HV
A125411E01
OK
10
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTOR (INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY)
(a) Check that the C6 connector is connected securely.
OK:
Connector is connected securely.
OK
C6
A125412E01
NG
Go to step 12
HV–122
11
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the C6 connector.
(b) Check that the C6 connector terminal does not have
burnout.
OK:
There is no burnout.
C6
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE CONNECTOR
A125412E01
OK
12
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY BATTERY AND BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the C5 and C6 converter inverter connectors.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
C5
IGCT
S
1 2 3
4 5 6
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
C5-3 (S) - Body ground
Always
Some as 12 V battery
voltage
Inverter with Converter Assembly
C6-1 (AMD) - Body
ground
Always
Some as 12 V battery
voltage
C5-1 (IGCT) - Body
ground
Power switch ON (IG)
8 to 16 V
NODD
HV
C6
(d) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
1
AMD
Inverter with Converter Assembly
A125414E01
OK
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
C5-4 (NODD) - Body
ground
IG-OFF
100 to 140 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
13
HV–123
CHECK OPERATION OF INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
C6
C5
C6
A125415E01
(a) Connect the C5 and C6 converter inverter connectors.
(b) Set the electrical tester with the AC/DC 400 A probe to
the wire harness of the C6 connector.
(c) Connect the I14 and I15 connectors (color: orange) to
the inverter.
(d) Install the inverter cover.
(e) Install the service plug grip.
(f) Turn the power switch ON (READY).
(g) Wait 5 minutes.
(h) Operate the electrical devices as listed below:
• Set the light control switch to High beam.
• Set the heater blower fan to HI.
• Turn on the defogger.
• Depress the brake pedal.
• Press all the switches of the window regulator master
switch at the same time.
• Turn the steering wheel to the right or left.
(i) Measure the amperage and voltage.
Standard amperage
Item
Specified Condition
Output current
40 to 100 A
Standard voltage
Item
Specified Condition
Battery voltage
13 to 15 V
OK
Go to step 15
NG
14
INSPECT FUSE
(a) Remove the EPS-H, HEAD MAIN-H, H-LP LO LH, H-LP
LO RH, H-LP HI LH, and H-LP HI RH fuses from the
engine room relay block.
(b) Remove the DEF-H, PWR-H, FR-DOOR, STOP M/HTR,
A/C (HTR) fuses from the driver side junction block.
(c) Measure the resistance of the fuses.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
CHECK FOR SHORT IN ALL HARNESS OR
CONNECTORS CONNECTED TO FUSE AND
REPLACE FUSE
OK
15
CHECK COOLANT LEVEL OF INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the coolant level in the reservoir tank.
HV
HV–124
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
OK:
Coolant level in the reservoir tank is between F and
L line.
NG
ADD COOLANT
OK
16
CHECK INVERTER COOLANT HOSE
(a) Check if the inverter cooling hoses are bent, twisted,
damaged or clogged.
OK:
Hoses are not bent, twisted, damaged, or clogged.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HOSE
OK
17
CHECK CONNECTION CONDITION OF WATER PUMP WITH MOTOR CONNECTOR
(LOOSENESS AND POOR CONNECTION)
(a) Check the connection condition of the pump and bracket
connector.
OK:
Connector has been connected securely.
NG
HV
CONNECT SECURELY
A090415E01
OK
18
CHECK OPERATION OF WATER PUMP WITH MOTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Check the operation of the motor.
OK:
Coolant surface in reservoir tank has waves.
NG
OK
REPLACE WATER PUMP WITH MOTOR
ASSEMBLY
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
19
HV–125
CHECK CONNECTION CONDITION OF COOLING FAN MOTOR CONNECTOR
(LOOSENESS AND POOR CONNECTION)
(a) Check the connection condition of the fan connectors.
OK:
Connectors have been connected securely.
NG
CONNECT SECURELY
A090546E01
OK
20
INSPECT COOLING FAN MOTOR
(a) Inspect cooling fan motor (see page CO-5).
NG
REPLACE COOLING FAN MOTOR
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
HV
HV–126
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A09265
DC / DC Converter Status Circuit Low Input
DTC
P0A10263
DC / DC Converter Status Circuit High Input
DESCRIPTION
The DC / DC converter converts the DC 201.6 V of the HV battery into DC 12 V in order to supply power
to the vehicle's lighting, audio and ECU systems. In addition, it charges the auxiliary battery.
A transistor bridge circuit initially converts DC 201.6 V into alternating current, and a transformer lowers its
voltage. Then, it is rectified and smoothed (into DC) and converted into DC 12 V.
The DC / DC converter controls the output voltage in order to keep a constant voltage at the terminals of
the auxiliary battery.
Inverter
DC 201.6 V
DC / DC Converter
HV
Input
Filter
AMD
GND
IG
Converter Control Circuit
S
Auxiliary Battery
NODD
VLO
HV Control ECU
IDH
A/C ECU
A125416E01
HV–127
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
The HV control ECU uses the NODD signal line to transmit a stop command to the DC / DC converter and
receive signals indicating the normal or abnormal conditions of the 12 V charging system.
If the vehicle is being driven with an inoperative DC / DC converter, the voltage of the auxiliary battery will
drop, which will prevent the continued operation of the vehicle. Therefore, the HV control ECU monitors
the operation of the DC / DC converter and alerts the driver if it detects a malfunction.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A09
265
Open or GND short in NODD
signal circuit of DC / DC converter
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0A10
263
+B short in NODD signal circuit of
DC / DC converter
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
WIRING DIAGRAM
DC / DC Converter
HV Control ECU
4
NODD C5
V
24
H16 NODD
A092298E01
HV
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - DC / DC
CONVERTER)
(a) Disconnect the H16 HV control ECU connector.
H16
NODD
HV Control ECU Connector
A065745E35
HV–128
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
(b) Disconnect the C5 DC / DC converter connector.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Measure the voltage between the terminal of the HV
control ECU connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side:
C5
NODD
DC / DC Converter Connector
A092030E01
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
NODD (H16-24) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(e) Turn the power switch OFF.
(f) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
NODD (H16-24) - NODD (C5-4)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
NODD (H16-24) or NODD (C5-4) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(g) Reconnect the DC / DC converter connector.
(h) Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
HV
HV–129
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A09591
DC / DC Converter Status Circuit Low Input
DTC
P0A10592
DC / DC Converter Status Circuit High Input
DESCRIPTION
See the description of the DC / DC converter (see page HV-124).
The HV control ECU sends the output voltage switch signal to the DC / DC converter via the VLO signal
line in order to switch output voltage according to vehicle status.
If the vehicle is being driven with an inoperative DC / DC converter, the voltage of the auxiliary battery will
drop, which will prevent the continued operation of the vehicle. Therefore, the HV control ECU monitors
the operation of the DC / DC converter and alerts the driver if it detects a malfunction.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A09
591
Open or GND short in VLO signal
circuit of DC / DC converter
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0A10
592
+B short in VLO signal circuit of
DC / DC converter
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
WIRING DIAGRAM
HV Control ECU
DC / DC Converter
HV
5
VLO C5
L
31
H16 VLO
A092298E02
HV–130
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - DC / DC
CONVERTER)
(a) Disconnect the H16 HV control ECU connector.
H16
VLO
HV Control ECU Connector
A065745E36
Wire Harness Side:
(b) Disconnect the C5 DC / DC converter connector.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Measure the voltage between the terminal of the HV
control ECU connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
C5
VLO
DC / DC Converter Connector
A092030E02
HV
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VLO (H16-31) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(e) Turn the power switch OFF.
(f) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VLO (H16-31) - VLO (C5-5)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VLO (H16-31) or VLO (C5-5) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(g) Reconnect the DC / DC converter connector.
(h) Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A0D350
HV–131
High Voltage System Inter-Lock Circuit High
DESCRIPTION
If the HV control ECU detects the operation of the safety devices (removal of the service plug grip and
inverter cover) while the vehicle is stopped (vehicle speed below 3 mph [5 km/h]), it will shut down the
system main relays. If the safety devices are correctly reinstalled, it will resume the normal operation after
the power source is supplied again. If it does not, there is a possibility of an open circuit, so perform the
same inspection as the DTC P0A0D (INF 351).
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A0D
350
Operating safety devices with
vehicle stopped (ILK signal is ON)
•
•
Service plug grip installation
Inverter cover installation
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK SERVICE PLUG GRIP INSTALLATION
(a) Check that the service plug grip has been installed
properly.
OK:
The service plug grip has been installed properly
NG
CORRECTLY REINSTALL
OK
2
CHECK INVERTER COVER INSTALLATION
(a) Check that the inverter cover has been installed properly.
OK:
The Inverter cover has been installed properly
NG
OK
GO TO DTC P0A0D-351
CORRECTLY REINSTALL
HV
HV–132
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
P0A0D351
DTC
High Voltage System Inter-Lock Circuit High
DESCRIPTION
A short pin for the interlock switch is provided on the service plug grip and the inverter cover. Therefore,
the interlock signal line circuit opens when the service plug grip or the inverter cover is removed.
If the HV control ECU detects an open circuit in the interlock signal line while the vehicle is in motion
(vehicle speed above 3 mph [5 km/h]), it stores the information (INF) code 351 in its memory and alerts
the driver.
While the vehicle is in motion, the HV control ECU will not shut down the high-voltage system even if an
open circuit in the interlock system is detected.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A0D
351
Open in interlock signal circuit
while vehicle is running
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Battery plug (No. 2 interlock
switch)
Inverter with converter
assembly (No. 1 interlock
switch)
WIRING DIAGRAM
HV Control ECU
L
HV
21
IC1
3
IC1
L
V
1
H15 ILK
V
1 I16
CVSW
Inverter with
No. 1 Interlock Converter
Switch
Assembly
2
IRTN
No. 2 Interlock
Switch
1
ILK
I17
Battery Plug
A129405E02
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–133
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
CHECK INVERTER COVER INSTALLATION
(a) Check that the inverter cover has been installed properly.
Standard:
The inverter cover has been installed properly
NG
CORRECTLY REINSTALL
OK
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - NO. 2
INTERLOCK SWITCH)
(a) Disconnect the H15 HV control ECU connector.
H15
HV
ILK
HV Control ECU Connector
A065744E20
(b) Disconnect the I17 No. 2 interlock switch connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Wire Harness Side:
No. 2 Interlock Switch Connector
I17
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
ILK (H15-1) - ILK (I17-1)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
A092089E01
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
ILK (H15-1) or ILK (I17-1) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the No. 2 interlock switch connector.
(e) Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
NG
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
HV–134
3
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (NO. 1 INTERLOCK SWITCH - NO. 2 INTERLOCK
SWITCH)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-153).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
(d) Disconnect the I16 No. 1 interlock switch connector.
Wire Harness Side:
CVSW
I16
No. 1 Interlock Switch Connector
A092059E01
(e) Disconnect the I17 No. 2 interlock switch connector.
(f) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Wire Harness Side:
No. 2 Interlock Switch Connector
HV
I17
IRTN
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
CVSW (I16-1) - IRTN (I17-2)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
A092090E01
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
CVSW (I16-1) or IRTN (I17-2) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(g) Reconnect the No. 1 interlock switch connector.
(h) Reconnect the No. 2 interlock switch connector.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
4
INSPECT INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Check that the service plug grip and inverter cover have
been removed.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
I16
CVSW
B
A
Ground Bolt
A092060E01
HV–135
(b) Disconnect the I16 No. 1 interlock switch connector.
(c) Check that the ground bolt for the interlock switch is
tightened to the specified torque.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
(d) Connect terminals A and B as shown in the illustration.
(e) Measure the resistance between the I16 No. 1 interlock
switch connector and body ground.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
CVSW (I16-1) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
(f) Reconnect the No. 1 interlock switch connector.
(g) Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
(h) Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
REPAIR HARNESS OR CONNECTOR, OR
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
OK
REPLACE BATTERY PLUG
HV
HV–136
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A0F204
Engine Failed to Start
DTC
P0A0F205
Engine Failed to Start
DTC
P0A0F533
Engine Failed to Start
DTC
P0A0F534
Engine Failed to Start
DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU performs the fail-safe control, when the ECM detects an error which will affect THS
control.
HV
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A0F
204
Abnormal signal input from ECM
(abnormal engine output)
•
•
ECM
SFI system
P0A0F
205
Abnormal signal input from ECM
(engine is unable to start)
•
•
ECM
SFI system
P0A0F
533
Abnormal signal input from ECM
(abnormal engine output by
running out of fuel)
•
•
ECM
SFI system
P0A0F
534
Abnormal signal input from ECM
(engine is unable to start by
running out of fuel)
•
•
ECM
SFI system
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ OUTPUT DTC (ENGINE)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTCs are output
NG
OK
REPLACE ECM
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
HV–137
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
P0A0F238
DTC
Engine Failed to Start
DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU detects this DTC and effects fail-safe control if the engine or transaxle gear has
seized up, or foreign objects have been caught in either of them.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A0F
238
Engine does not start even
though cranking it
(transaxle input malfunction
[engine system])
•
•
•
•
•
Engine assembly
HV transaxle assembly (shaft
or gear)
Transmission input damper
Wire harness or connector
HV control ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
HV Control ECU
ECM
1
NEO E7
33
NE+ E4
34
NE- E4
12
H16 NEO
LG
G
A
A
*
R
1
G
2
J14
J/C
C7
Crankshaft
Position
Sensor
BR
A
A
J12
J/C
*: Shielded
HV
BR
EC
A092095E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ OUTPUT DTC (ENGINE)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTCs are output
YES
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
HV–138
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
NO
2
CHECK CRANKSHAFT PULLEY REVOLUTION
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Jack up the vehicle.
(c) Manually turn the crankshaft pulley to check if the
crankshaft rotates.
OK:
The crankshaft rotates
NG
Go to step 11
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (ECM - CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR)
(a) Disconnect the E4 ECM connector.
E4
NENE+
ECM Connector
A065743E70
HV
(b) Disconnect the C7 crankshaft position sensor connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Wire Harness Side:
C7
Crankshaft Position Sensor Connector
A092031E01
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
NE+ (E4-33) - Crankshaft position
sensor (C7-1)
Below 1 Ω
NE- (E4-34) - Crankshaft position
sensor (C7-2)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
NE+ (E4-33) or Crankshaft position
sensor (C7-1) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NE- (E4-34) or Crankshaft position
sensor (C7-2) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the crankshaft position sensor connector.
(e) Reconnect the ECM connector.
NG
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
4
HV–139
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the H16 HV control ECU connector.
H16
NEO
HV Control ECU Connector
A065745E37
(b) Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E7
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
NEO (H16-12) - NEO (E7-1)
Below 1 Ω
NEO
ECM Connector
A065744E24
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
NEO (H16-12) or NEO (E7-1) -Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(e) Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
5
CHECK AND CLEAR DTC (HV ECU)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Check and record the DTCs, the freeze frame data, and
the information.
(f) Clear the DTCs of the HV ECU.
GO
6
CHECK READY LIGHT
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DATA LIST.
HV
HV–140
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
(e) Read the MG1 REV and ENGINE SPD values.
(f) Turn the power switch ON (READY).
OK:
READY light turns ON
HINT:
If the READY light does not turn ON, and the reading on
the intelligent tester shows DTC P0A90 (INF 239) (HV
transaxle input malfunction [shaft damaged]), or the MG1
turns but the engine does not crank, replace the hybrid
vehicle transaxle assembly.
NG
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE
ASSEMBLY
OK
7
CHECK ENGINE REV-UP
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DATA LIST.
(e) Read the MG1 REV and ENGINE SPD values.
(f) With the READY light turned ON, depress the
accelerator pedal for 10 seconds while the shift position
is in P.
OK:
The engine revs up
HINT:
If the engine does not rev up, and the reading on the
intelligent tester shows DTC P0A90 (INF 239) (HV
transaxle input malfunction [shaft damaged]), or the MG1
turns but the engine does not crank, replace the hybrid
vehicle transaxle assembly.
HV
NG
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE
ASSEMBLY
OK
8
CHECK CREEP MOVEMENT
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (READY).
Jack up the vehicle.
Depress the brake pedal, move the selector lever to the
D position, and release the brake pedal.
OK:
The wheels turn (creep movement)
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–141
HINT:
If the wheels do not turn, and the reading on the
intelligent tester shows DTC P0A90 (INF 602) (HV
transaxle output malfunction), replace the hybrid vehicle
transaxle assembly.
NG
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE
ASSEMBLY
OK
9
CHECK ENGINE ACCELERATION SPEED
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) While driving at the vehicle speed of more than 6 mph
(10 km/h), fully depress the accelerator pedal to raise the
engine speed.
OK:
The engine speed increases smoothly
HINT:
If the engine over-revs or the reading on the intelligent
tester shows DTC P0A90 (INF 241) (HV transaxle input
malfunction [torque limiter slipping]), replace the
transmission input damper.
NG
REPLACE TRANSMISSION INPUT DAMPER
ASSEMBLY
OK
10
CHECK CAUSE OF INCREASE IN REVOLUTION RESISTANCE
(a) Investigate what has caused the revolution resistance of
the transaxle and engine to become greater.
(1) Check the engine lubrication system and transaxle
lubrication system.
(2) Check the engine coolant and transaxle coolant.
(3) Check for any breakdowns in the engine and
transaxle.
Result:
There is no fault
NO
REPAIR MALFUNCTIONING PARTS AND
COMPONENTS
YES
PERFORM SIMULATION TEST. IF SYMPTOM IS NOT REPRODUCED, REPLACE ENGINE, HV
TRANSAXLE AND HV CONTROL ECU
11
CHECK FRONT TIRE REVOLUTION
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HV
HV–142
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
(b) Depress the brake pedal, move the selector lever to the
N position.
(c) Jack up the vehicle.
(d) Manually turn the crankshaft pulley to check if the front
tires rotate.
OK:
The front tires rotate
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE ENGINE ASSEMBLY
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
HV
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A1D134
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DTC
P0A1D135
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DTC
P0A1D570
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
HV–143
DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU performs self-checks to detect an internal operating malfunction in the ECU.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A1D
134
135
570
HV control ECU internal error
•
HV control ECU
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU performs diagnostic monitoring to verify proper operation of vehicle systems.
One of these monitors the rationality of internal analog (signal) to digital conversions.
The HV control ECU monitors the internal A/D (Analog / Digital Converter) value. If there is an A/D
malfunction, the HV control ECU will illuminate the MIL and set a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A1D (INF 134 / 135 / 570):
ADC malfunction
Required sensor / components
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
1 driving cycle
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
Internal error
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
DTC P0A1D (INF 134 / 135 / 570) is not detected
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
If any of the above information (INF) codes are present, replace the HV control ECU.
HV
HV–144
1
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
(a) Replace the hybrid vehicle control ECU (see page HV543).
NEXT
COMPLETED
HV
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A1D139
HV–145
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU performs self-checks to detect an internal operating malfunction in the ECU.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A1D
139
HV control ECU internal error
•
HV control ECU
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU performs diagnostic monitoring to verify proper operation of vehicle systems. One of
these monitors checks the inside of the HV control ECU for a bad integrated circuit which actuates a relay.
If the HV control ECU detects a malfunction, it will illuminate the MIL and set a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A1D (INF 139): IG malfunction
Required sensor / components
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
1 driving cycle
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
HV
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
Internal error
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
DTC P0A1D (INF 139) is not detected
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
If the above information (INF) code is present, replace the HV control ECU.
1
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
(a) Replace the hybrid vehicle control ECU (see page HV543).
NEXT
COMPLETED
HV–146
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A1D140
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU performs self-checks to detect an internal operating malfunction in the ECU.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A1D
140
HV control ECU internal error
•
HV control ECU
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU performs many diagnostic tests to verify proper operation of internal ECU systems.
One of these tests checks for errors after a memory read / write diagnostic test.
If the HV control ECU detects this malfunction inside of the ECU, it will illuminate the MIL and set a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A1D (INF 140): RAM destruction
Required sensor / components
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
1 driving cycle
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
HV
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
All RAM area
Read / write check error
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
DTC P0A1D (INF 140) is not detected
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
If the above information (INF) code is present, replace the HV control ECU.
1
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
(a) Replace the hybrid vehicle control ECU (see page HV543).
NEXT
COMPLETED
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A1D141
HV–147
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU performs self-checks to detect an internal operating malfunction in the ECU.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A1D
141
HV control ECU internal error
•
HV control ECU
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU performs many diagnostic tests to verify proper operation of internal ECU systems.
One of these tests checks for errors in the ROM (Read Only Memory) circuits of the HV control ECU.
If the HV control ECU detects this malfunction inside of the ECU, it will illuminate the MIL and set a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A1D (INF 141): ROM destruction
Required sensor / components
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
1 driving cycle
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
HV
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
Internal error
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
DTC P0A1D (INF 141) is not detected
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
If the above information (INF) code is present, replace the HV control ECU.
1
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
(a) Replace the hybrid vehicle control ECU (see page HV543).
NEXT
COMPLETED
HV–148
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
P0A1D142
DTC
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DESCRIPTION
When the ST turned ON in the ignition switch on the previous model, the ignition switch transmitted the
ST signal to the HV control ECU.
The new Prius has adopted a push button start system. When the driver pushes on the power switch
while depressing the brake pedal, the power source control ECU transmits the ST signal to the HV control
ECU.
Previous ST Signal:
Push Button Start System’s ST Signal:
Ignition Switch
Stop Light Switch
ST2
STSW
STP
SSW
HV Control ECU
Auxiliary
Battery
Auxiliary
Battery
AM
ST2
HV Control ECU
Power Switch
Power Source
Control ECU
HV
A093723E01
The HV control ECU monitors the ST signal to detect malfunction. If the ST signal is shorted to the +B
power supply, the ST will be constantly ON, which will cause the HV system to start by merely turning the
power switch ON (IG). The HV control ECU monitors the ST signal to prevent this from occurring.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A1D
142
ST signal of HV control ECU is
ON with power switch OFF
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Power source control ECU
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU monitors an ST signal input from the power source control ECU. If the ST signal is
shorted to the +B power supply, the HV control ECU interprets this as the ST signal error, and then
illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A1D (INF142): ST malfunction
Required sensor / components
Power source control ECU
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
1 driving cycle
Sequence of operation
None
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–149
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
ST signal
ON
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
ST signal
OFF (when the power switch OFF)
WIRING DIAGRAM
P6
Power Source Control ECU
HV Control ECU
No. 1 Center Connector
STSW
39
Y
10
4J
6
4E
Y
5
H14 ST2
A092096E01
HV
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU (ST2 VOLTAGE)
(a) Disconnect the H14 HV control ECU connector.
(b) Measure the voltage between the terminal of the HV
control ECU connector and body ground with the power
switch turned OFF.
Standard voltage
H14
ST2
HV Control ECU Connector
A065748E29
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
ST2 (H14-5) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(c) Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
OK
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
HV–150
2
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - POWER
SOURCE CONTROL ECU)
(a) Disconnect the H14 HV control ECU connector.
H14
ST2
HV Control ECU Connector
A065748E29
Wire Harness Side:
STSW
P6
Power Source Control ECU Connector
A092032E01
(b) Disconnect the P6 power source control ECU connector.
(c) Measure the voltage between the terminal of the HV
control ECU connector or power source control ECU and
body ground with the power switch turned OFF.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
ST2 (H14-5) or STSW (P6-39) - Body
ground
Below 1 V
(d) Reconnect the power source control ECU connector.
(e) Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
NG
OK
HV
REPLACE POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A1D143
HV–151
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU performs self-checks to detect an internal operating malfunction in the ECU.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A1D
143
HV control ECU internal error
•
HV control ECU
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU performs diagnostic monitoring to verify proper operation of internal ECU systems.
One of these monitors compares read and write values at the inside of the HV control ECU memory,
which have been indicated by the transponder key or the electronic key.
If those two values are inconsistent with each other, the HV control ECU interprets this as an ECU
memory failure of the HV control ECU. The HV control ECU illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A1D (INF 143): EEPROM malfunction
Required sensor / components
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
1 driving cycle
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Immobilizer and electronic key area on the EEPROM
Read / write check error
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
DTC P0A1D (INF 143) is not detected
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
If the above information (INF) code is present, replace the HV control ECU.
1
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
(a) Replace the hybrid vehicle control ECU (see page HV543).
NEXT
COMPLETED
HV
HV–152
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A1D144
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DTC
P0A1D145
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU performs self-checks to detect an internal operating malfunction in the ECU.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A1D
144
145
HV control ECU internal error
•
HV control ECU
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU performs many diagnostic tests to verify proper operation of internal ECU systems.
In one of these diagnostics, the HV control ECU performs a self-test.
If the HV control ECU detects an internal problem during this self-test, it will conclude that there is an
internal malfunction. The HV control ECU will illuminate the MIL and set a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A1D (INF 144 / 145):
Primary check malfunction
Required sensor / components
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
1 driving cycle
Sequence of operation
None
HV
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Either of the following conditions 1 or 2 is met:
-
1. Reset signal from engine CPU
Not found
2. Communication time between internal ECUs
Time out
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
DTC P0A1D (INF 144 / 145) is not detected
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
If any of the above information (INF) codes are present, replace the HV control ECU.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
1
HV–153
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
(a) Replace the hybrid vehicle control ECU (see page HV543).
NEXT
COMPLETED
HV
HV–154
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A1D148
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DTC
P0A1D149
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU performs self-checks to detect an internal operating malfunction in the ECU.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A1D
148
149
HV control ECU internal error
•
HV control ECU
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU performs many diagnostic tests to verify proper operation of internal ECU systems.
In one of these diagnostics, the HV control ECU performs a self-test.
If the HV control ECU detects an internal problem during this self-test, it will conclude that there is an
internal malfunction. The HV control ECU will illuminate the MIL and set a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
HV
Related DTCs
P0A1D (INF 148 / 149): HV CPU malfunction
Required sensor / components
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
1 driving cycle
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
Internal error
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
DTC P0A1D (INF 148 / 149) is not detected
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
If any of the above information (INF) codes are present, replace the HV control ECU.
1
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
(a) Replace the hybrid vehicle control ECU (see page HV543).
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–155
NEXT
COMPLETED
HV
HV–156
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A1D150
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DTC
P0A1D151
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DTC
P0A1D152
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DTC
P0A1D155
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DTC
P0A1D156
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DTC
P0A1D158
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DTC
P0A1D564
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU performs self-checks to detect an internal operating malfunction in the ECU.
HV
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A1D
150
151
152
155
156
158
564
HV control ECU internal error
•
HV control ECU
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU performs many diagnostic tests to verify proper operation of internal and external
ECU systems. In one of these diagnostics, the HV control ECU checks the result of the generator CPU
self-test. If the HV control ECU detects a "Fail" from the generator CPU self-test, it will conclude that there
is an internal malfunction in the generator CPU. The HV control ECU will illuminate the MIL and set a
DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A1D (INF 150 / 151 / 152 / 155 / 156 / 158 / 564):
Generator CPU malfunction
Required sensor / components
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
1 driving cycle
Sequence of operation
None
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–157
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
Internal error
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
DTC P0A1D (INF 150 / 151 / 152 / 155 / 156 / 158 / 564) is not
detected
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
If any of the above information (INF) codes are present, replace the HV control ECU.
1
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
(a) Replace the hybrid vehicle control ECU (see page HV543).
NEXT
COMPLETED
HV
HV–158
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A1D159
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DTC
P0A1D160
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU performs self-checks to detect an internal operating malfunction in the ECU.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A1D
159
160
HV control ECU internal error
•
HV control ECU
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU performs many diagnostic tests to verify proper operation of internal and external
ECU systems. In one of these monitors, the HV control ECU checks the motor main CPU serial
communication link.
If the HV control ECU detects a failure, it will conclude that there is an internal malfunction involving the
HV control ECU to motor main CPU communication link. The HV control ECU will illuminate the MIL and
set a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
HV
Related DTCs
P0A1D (INF 159 / 160):
Motor CPU serial communication error
Required sensor / components
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
1 driving cycle
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
Internal error
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
DTC P0A1D (INF 159 / 160) is not detected
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
If any of the above information (INF) codes is present, replace the HV control ECU.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
1
HV–159
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
(a) Replace the hybrid vehicle control ECU (see page HV543).
NEXT
COMPLETED
HV
HV–160
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A1D163
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DTC
P0A1D164
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DTC
P0A1D511
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DTC
P0A1D512
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU performs self-checks to detect an internal operating malfunction in the ECU.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A1D
163
164
511
512
HV control ECU internal error
•
HV control ECU
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
HV
The HV control ECU performs diagnostic monitoring to verify proper operation of internal and external
ECU systems. In one of these monitors, the HV control ECU monitors the power supply for the motor
main CPU.
If the HV control ECU detects a failure in the power supply for the motor main CPU, it will illuminate the
MIL and set a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A1D (INF 163 / 164 / 511 / 512):
Motor ECU power malfunction
Required sensor / components
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
1 driving cycle
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
Internal error
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
DTC P0A1D (INF 163 / 164 / 511 / 512) is not detected
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–161
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
If any of the above information (INF) codes are present, replace the HV control ECU.
1
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
(a) Replace the hybrid vehicle control ECU (see page HV543).
NEXT
COMPLETED
HV
HV–162
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A1D165
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DTC
P0A1D168
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DTC
P0A1D198
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DTC
P0A1D199
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU performs self-checks to detect an internal operating malfunction in the ECU.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A1D
165
168
198
199
HV control ECU internal error
•
HV control ECU
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
HV
The HV control ECU performs diagnostic monitoring to verify proper operation of internal and external
ECU systems. In this diagnostic monitor, the HV control ECU checks for an R/D (Resolver / Digital
Converter) malfunction involving the motor resolver.
If the HV control ECU detects an R/D error, it will conclude that there is an internal malfunction involving
the motor resolver. The HV control ECU will illuminate the MIL and set a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A1D (INF 165 / 168 / 198 / 199):
Motor R/D malfunction
Required sensor / components
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
1 driving cycle
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
Internal error
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
DTC P0A1D (INF 165 / 168 / 198 / 199) is not detected
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–163
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
If any of the above information (INF) codes are present, replace the HV control ECU.
1
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
(a) Replace the hybrid vehicle control ECU (see page HV543).
NEXT
COMPLETED
HV
HV–164
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A1D166
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DTC
P0A1D167
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DTC
P0A1D197
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DTC
P0A1D200
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU performs self-checks to detect an internal operating malfunction in the ECU.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A1D
166
167
197
200
HV control ECU internal error
•
HV control ECU
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
HV
The HV control ECU performs diagnostic monitoring to verify proper operation of internal and external
ECU systems. In this diagnostic monitor, the HV control ECU checks for an R/D (Resolver / Digital
Converter) malfunction involving the generator resolver.
If the HV control ECU detects an R/D error, it will conclude that there is an internal malfunction involving
the generator resolver. The HV control ECU will illuminate the MIL and set a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A1D (INF 166 / 167 / 197 / 200):
Generator R/D malfunction
Required sensor / components
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
1 driving cycle
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
Internal error
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
DTC P0A1D (INF 166 / 167 / 197 / 200) is not detected
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–165
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
If any of the above information (INF) codes are present, replace the HV control ECU.
1
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
(a) Replace the hybrid vehicle control ECU (see page HV543).
NEXT
COMPLETED
HV
HV–166
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A1D177
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DTC
P0A1D178
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DTC
P0A1D392
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DTC
P0A1D567
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU performs self-checks to detect an internal operating malfunction in the ECU.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A1D
177
178
392
567
HV control ECU internal error
•
HV control ECU
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
HV
The HV control ECU performs many diagnostic tests to verify proper operation of internal and external
ECU systems. In one of these diagnostics, the HV control ECU checks the result of the motor main CPU
self-test.
If the HV control ECU detects a "Fail" from the motor main CPU self-test, it will conclude that there is an
internal malfunction in the motor main CPU. The HV control ECU will illuminate the MIL and set a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A1D (INF 177 / 178 / 392 / 567):
Motor main CPU malfunction
Required sensor / components
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
1 driving cycle
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
Internal error
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
DTC P0A1D (INF 177 / 178 / 392 / 567) is not detected
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–167
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
If any of the above information (INF) codes are present, replace the HV control ECU.
1
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
(a) Replace the hybrid vehicle control ECU (see page HV543).
NEXT
COMPLETED
HV
HV–168
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A1D180
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DTC
P0A1D181
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DTC
P0A1D182
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DTC
P0A1D183
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DTC
P0A1D184
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DTC
P0A1D185
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DTC
P0A1D186
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU performs self-checks to detect an internal operating malfunction in the ECU.
HV
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A1D
180
181
182
183
184
185
186
HV control ECU internal error
•
HV control ECU
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU performs diagnostic monitoring to verify proper operation of internal and external
ECU systems. In this diagnostics monitor, the HV control ECU monitors the output of the rotation angle
CPU.
If the HV control ECU detects an error in the rotation angle CPU, it will conclude that there is an internal
malfunction in the HV control ECU. The HV control ECU will illuminate the MIL and set a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A1D (INF 180 / 181 / 182 / 183 / 184 / 185 / 186):
Rotation angle monitor CPU malfunction
Required sensor / components
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
1 driving cycle
Sequence of operation
None
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–169
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
Internal error
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
DTC P0A1D (INF 180 / 181 / 182 / 183 / 184 / 185 / 186) is not
detected
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
If any of the above information (INF) codes are present, replace the HV control ECU.
1
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
(a) Replace the hybrid vehicle control ECU (see page HV543).
NEXT
COMPLETED
HV
HV–170
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A1D187
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU performs self-checks to detect an internal operating malfunction in the ECU.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A1D
187
HV control ECU internal error
•
HV control ECU
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU performs diagnostic monitoring to verify proper operation of internal and external
ECU systems. In one of these diagnostics, the HV control ECU monitors the important RAM circuits of the
HV control ECU.
If the HV control ECU detects an error in the important RAM circuits, it will conclude that there is an
internal malfunction in the HV control ECU. The HV control ECU will illuminate the MIL and set a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A1D (INF 187): Important RAM error
Required sensor / components
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
1 driving cycle
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
HV
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Important RAM address
Read / write check error
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
DTC P0A1D (INF 187) is not detected
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
If the above information (INF) code is present, replace the HV control ECU.
1
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
(a) Replace the hybrid vehicle control ECU (see page HV543).
NEXT
COMPLETED
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A1D188
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DTC
P0A1D189
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DTC
P0A1D192
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DTC
P0A1D193
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DTC
P0A1D195
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DTC
P0A1D196
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DTC
P0A1D565
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
HV–171
DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU performs self-checks to detect an internal operating malfunction in the ECU.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A1D
188
189
192
193
195
196
565
HV control ECU internal error
•
HV control ECU
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU performs many diagnostic tests to verify proper operation of internal and external
ECU systems. In one of these diagnostics, the HV control ECU checks the result of the motor CPU selftest.
If the HV control ECU detects a "Fail" from the motor CPU self-test, it will conclude that there is an internal
malfunction in the motor CPU. The HV control ECU will illuminate the MIL and set a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A1D (INF 188 / 189 / 192 / 193 / 195 / 196 / 565):
Motor CPU malfunction
Required sensor / components
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
1 driving cycle
Sequence of operation
None
HV
HV–172
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
Internal error
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
DTC P0A1D (INF 188 / 189 / 192 / 193 / 195 / 196 / 565) is not
detected
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
If any of the above information (INF) codes are present, replace the HV control ECU.
1
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
(a) Replace the hybrid vehicle control ECU (see page HV543).
NEXT
COMPLETED
HV
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A1D390
HV–173
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU performs self-checks to detect an internal operating malfunction in the ECU.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A1D
390
Charge control malfunction
•
HV control ECU
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV ECU)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTC P0A1D (INF 390) and other DTCs are output
HINT:
If any other codes besides P0A1D (INF 390) are output,
perform troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
YES
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
NO
HV
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
HV–174
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A1D393
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU performs self-checks to detect an internal operating malfunction in the ECU.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A1D
393
HV control ECU internal error
•
HV control ECU
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU performs many diagnostic tests to verify proper operation of internal ECU systems.
In one of these diagnostics, the HV control ECU performs a self-test.
If the HV control ECU detects an internal problem during this self-test, it will conclude that there is an
internal malfunction. The HV control ECU will illuminate the MIL and set a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A1D (INF 393):
HV CPU operation malfunction (routine check)
Required sensor / components
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
1 driving cycle
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
HV
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
Internal error
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
DTC P0A1D (INF 393) is not detected
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
If the above information (INF) code is present, replace the HV control ECU.
1
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
(a) Replace the hybrid vehicle control ECU (see page HV543).
NEXT
COMPLETED
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A1D568
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DTC
P0A1D569
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
HV–175
DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU performs self-checks to detect an internal operating malfunction in the ECU.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A1D
568
569
HV control ECU internal error
•
HV control ECU
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU performs diagnostic monitoring to verify proper operation of internal and external
ECU systems. In this diagnostics monitor, the HV control ECU checks the REF signal from the motor main
ECU for errors.
If the HV control ECU detects an error in the REF signal, it will conclude that there is a malfunction in the
motor main CPU, the REF signal or the HV control ECU. The HV control ECU illuminates the MIL and sets
a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A1D (INF 568 / 569):
Motor REF signal malfunction
Required sensor / components
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
1 driving cycle
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
REF signal
Abnormal
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
DTC P0A1D (INF 568 / 569) is not detected
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV ECU)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HV
HV–176
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
(c) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTC P0A0F (INF 243), P0A40 (INF 500) or P0A41
(INF 245) for the motor resolver is output
YES
NO
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
HV
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A1D615
HV–177
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU performs self-checks to detect an internal operating malfunction in the ECU.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A1D
615
HV control ECU internal error
•
HV control ECU
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU performs diagnostic monitoring to verify proper operation of internal and external
ECU systems. In this diagnostics monitor, the HV control ECU checks the communication bus off count
and the message register of the CAN (Controller Area Network) controller.
If the HV control ECU detects an error in the communication bus off count or message register, it will
conclude that there is a malfunction in the HV control ECU. The HV control ECU illuminates the MIL and
sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A1D (INF 615):
CAN communication malfunction
Required sensor / components
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
1 driving cycle
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Case 1:
Message register of the CAN controller
Read / write check error
Case 2:
Communication bus off count
Designed number or more
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
DTC P0A1D (INF 615) is not detected
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
If the above information (INF) code is present, replace the HV control ECU.
1
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
(a) Replace the hybrid vehicle control ECU (see page HV543).
HV
HV–178
NEXT
COMPLETED
HV
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A1F123
HV–179
Battery Energy Control Module
DESCRIPTION
Based on a malfunction signal received from the battery ECU, the HV control ECU alerts the driver and
effects fail-safe control.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A1F
123
Abnormal signal input from
battery ECU (ROM/RAM
malfunction)
•
•
HV battery system
Battery ECU
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
Upon receiving an abnormal signal input from the battery ECU, the HV control ECU illuminates the MIL
and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A1F (INF 123): Battery ECU / Rationality
Required sensor / components
Battery ECU, battery current sensor
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
HV
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Battery ECU
Normal
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After repairing the malfunction, restart the system (to turn the READY light ON) and recheck the DTC.
1
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV BATTERY)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV BATTERY / DTC INFO / TROUBLE CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
HV–180
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Result:
DTCs are output
YES
NO
REPLACE BATTERY ECU ASSEMBLY
HV
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A1F129
HV–181
Battery Energy Control Module
DESCRIPTION
The battery ECU transmits information on the HV battery voltage to the HV control ECU via CAN
communication.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A1F
129
HV battery voltage circuit
malfunction
•
•
•
•
•
HV battery voltage circuit
Service plug grip
High voltage fuse
Battery plug
Battery ECU
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU calculates the differences between the received HV battery voltage, boost converter
voltage, and inverter voltage. If any of the differences exceed prescribed values, the HV control ECU
determines that there is a malfunction in the battery voltage circuit. When the HV control ECU detects a
malfunction, it illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A1F (INF 129): Battery ECU / Voltage (VB) sensor deviation
Required sensor / components
Battery ECU, boost converter, inverter
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
HV
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Battery ECU
Normal
HV–182
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Battery ECU
(+)
Service Plug Grip
L-O
17
B12 VBB10
LG-R
7
B12 VBB9
O
O
High Voltage Fuse
(-)
A090438E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
HV
1
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV BATTERY)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV BATTERY / DTC INFO / TROUBLE CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTCs are output
YES
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
NO
2
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV ECU)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–183
Result:
DTCs listed in the table below are output
DTC No.
INF Code
Detection Item
See Page
P0ADC
226
Hybrid Battery Positive Contactor
Control Circuit High
HV-439
P0ADB
227
Hybrid Battery Positive Contactor
Control Circuit Low
HV-439
P0AE0
228
Hybrid Battery Negative
Contactor Control Circuit High
HV-441
P0ADF
229
Hybrid Battery Negative
Contactor Control Circuit Low
HV-441
YES
GO TO THE PAGE NUMBER SHOWN IN THE
TABLE ABOVE
NO
3
INSPECT SERVICE PLUG GRIP
A081749E01
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the
service plug grip.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
Go to step 5
OK
4
INSPECT BATTERY PLUG
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves and goggles before performing
the following operation.
(a) Remove the HV battery assembly (see page HB-92).
(b) Remove the battery plug (see page HB-113).
(c) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the
battery plug.
Standard resistance
A
B
D
C
A093184E01
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A-C
Below 1 Ω
B-D
Below 1 Ω
(d) Reinstall the battery plug (see page HB-114).
(e) Reinstall the HV battery assembly (see page HB-96).
HV
HV–184
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
NG
REPLACE BATTERY PLUG
OK
REPLACE BATTERY ECU ASSEMBLY
5
INSPECT HIGH VOLTAGE FUSE
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Remove the high voltage fuse (see page HB-154).
HINT:
The high voltage fuse is enclosed in the service plug
grip.
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the
high voltage fuse.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
(c) Reinstall the high voltage fuse (see page HB-154).
A057824E01
OK
REPLACE SERVICE PLUG GRIP
HV
NG
REPLACE HIGH VOLTAGE FUSE
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A1F593
HV–185
Battery Energy Control Module
DESCRIPTION
The battery ECU transmits information on the IG2 voltage of the battery ECU to the HV control ECU via
CAN communication.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A1F
593
IG2 signal circuit of battery ECU
malfunction
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Battery ECU
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
When the IG2 voltage of the battery ECU, which is transmitted while the power switch is ON (IG), is low,
the HV control ECU determines that a wiring malfunction has occurred at the IG2 terminal of the battery
ECU. When the HV control ECU detects the malfunction, it illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A1F (INF 593): IG2 signal malfunction
Required sensor / components
Battery ECU
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
1 driving cycle
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Following conditions are met:
(a) and (b)
(a) IG2 signal status at HV control ECU
ON
(b) IG2 signal status from battery ECU
OFF
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Battery ECU
DTC P0A1F (INF 593) is not detected
HV
HV–186
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Driver Side Junction Block
B
4
1J
B
1
6 4I
6 4G
7.5 A IGN
21
1E
2
A
J2
J/C
A
W
V
1
IA3
13
B11 IG2
O
15
1F
IA1
W
No. 1 Center Connector
Battery ECU
O
22 ID3
O
V
W
1 3A
4 3I
1 3K
1
B F15
Fusible
1 BE1 Link Block
B
3 3I
Engine Room
W
W-B Relay Block
4 IA1
1 4J
13 4E
1 4G
5 4K
35
IG2D
No. 1 Center
Connector
HV Control ECU
V
O
7
H14 IGSW
P6
Power Source
Control ECU
EF
3 4I
5 4J
Auxiliary
Battery
4 4G
3I
W
120 A
MAIN
1 4I
IG2
2
1 3M
HV
3I
15 A
AM2
60 A
P/I
1
2
1
2
1
O
AM2
No. 1 Center
Connector
12
W
A092097E01
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–187
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (BATTERY ECU - IGN FUSE)
(a) Disconnect the B11 battery ECU connector.
B11
Battery ECU Connector
IG2
A092033E01
Driver Side Junction Block:
IGN
fuse
(b) Remove the IGN fuse from the driver side junction block.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
IG2 (B11-13) - IGN fuse (2)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
A092034E01
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
IG2 (B11-13) or IGN fuse (2) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
NOTICE:
When taking a measurement with a tester, do not
apply excessive force to the tester probe to avoid
damaging the holder.
(d) Reinstall the IGN fuse.
(e) Reconnect the battery ECU connector.
NG
OK
REPLACE BATTERY ECU ASSEMBLY
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
HV
HV–188
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A2B248
Drive Motor "A" Temperature Sensor Circuit
Range / Performance
DTC
P0A2B250
Drive Motor "A" Temperature Sensor Circuit
Range / Performance
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0A2C (INF 247) (see page HV-187).
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A2B
248
No. 1 motor temperature sensor
malfunction
•
Hybrid vehicle motor
P0A2B
250
No. 1 motor temperature sensor
performance problem
•
Hybrid vehicle motor
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
If the information (INF) code 248 or 250 is present, replace the hybrid vehicle motor.
HINT:
The No. 1 motor temperature sensor is unavailable as an individual service part. Therefore, when
replacing it, the hybrid vehicle motor must be replaced.
1
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE MOTOR ASSEMBLY
NEXT
HV
COMPLETED
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–189
DTC
P0A2C247
Drive Motor "A" Temperature Sensor Circuit
Low
DTC
P0A2D249
Drive Motor "A" Temperature Sensor Circuit
High
DESCRIPTION
Resistance kΩ
(50) (59) (68) (77) (86) (95)(104)
Temperature °C (°F)
A092300E01
The resistance of the thermistor, which is enclosed in the No. 1 motor temperature sensor, changes in
accordance with the changes in the temperature of the motor. The lower the motor temperature, the
higher the resistance of the thermistor. Conversely, the higher the temperature, the lower the resistance.
The No. 1 motor temperature sensor is connected to the HV control ECU. The power voltage of 5 V is
supplied from the MMT terminal of the HV control ECU to the No. 1 motor temperature sensor via resistor
R. Because resistor R and the No. 1 motor temperature sensor are connected in series, the resistance
changes with the changes in temperature of the motor, which causes the MMT terminal voltage to also
change.
Based on this signal, the HV control ECU limits the load in order to prevent the motor from overheating.
Furthermore, the HV control ECU checks the No. 1 motor temperature sensor for a wiring malfunction and
the sensor for a malfunction.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A2C
247
GND short in No. 1 motor
temperature sensor circuit
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Hybrid vehicle motor
HV control ECU
P0A2D
249
Open or +B short in No. 1 motor
temperature sensor circuit
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Hybrid vehicle motor
HV control ECU
HINT:
After confirming DTC P0A2C (INF 247) or P0A2D (INF 249), confirm MOTOR 1 TEMP in DIAGNOSIS /
OBD/MOBD / HV ECU / DATA LIST using the intelligent tester.
Temperature Displayed
Malfunction
50°C (-58°F)
Open or +B short circuit
205°C (401°F)
GND short circuit
HV
HV–190
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
HV Control ECU
No. 2 Motor Generator
MMT
1
M10
B
18
MMT
H17
MMTG
4
M10
R
28
MMTG
H17
No. 1 Motor
Temperature Sensor
R
A092299E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (MOTOR 1 TEMP)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DATA LIST.
(e) Read the MOTOR 1 TEMP value.
HV
Result:
Temperature Displayed
Proceed to
-50°C (-58°F)
A
205°C (401°F)
B
-49°C to 204°C (-57°F to 400°F)
C
HINT:
• If there is an open or +B short circuit, the intelligent
tester indicates -50°C (-58°F).
• If there is a GND short circuit, the intelligent tester
indicates 205°C (401°F).
B
C
A
Go to step 5
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
HV–191
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
2
INSPECT HYBRID VEHICLE MOTOR ASSEMBLY (CHECK FOR OPEN OR +B SHORT)
No. 1 Motor Temperature
Sensor
HV Control ECU
(a) Disconnect the M10 No. 1 motor temperature sensor
connector.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
MMT
MMTG
A092038E01
(c) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the No. 1
motor temperature sensor connector.
Result:
Wire Harness Side:
M10
MTT (+)
MMTG (-)
No. 1 Motor Temperature Sensor Connector
Tester Connection
Voltage
Proceed to
MMT (M10-1) - MMTG
(M10-4)
Approximately 5 V
A
MMT (M10-1) - MMTG
(M10-4)
9 to 14 V
B
MMT (M10-1) - MMTG
(M10-4)
Approximately 0 V
C
A092036E01
HINT:
The No. 1 motor temperature sensor is unavailable as an
individual service part. Therefore, when replacing it, the
hybrid vehicle motor must be replaced.
(d) Reconnect the No. 1 motor temperature sensor
connector.
A
C
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE MOTOR
ASSEMBLY
Go to step 4
B
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (CHECK FOR +B SHORT)
(a) Disconnect the H17 HV control ECU connector.
H17
HV Control ECU Connector
A065743E71
HV
HV–192
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
(b) Disconnect the M10 No. 1 motor temperature sensor
connector.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Measure the voltage between the terminal of the No. 1
motor temperature sensor connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side:
M10
MMT (+)
No. 1 Motor Temperature Sensor Connector
A092036E02
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
MMT (M10-1) - Body ground
Approximately 0 V
(e) Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
(f) Reconnect the No. 1 motor temperature sensor
connector.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
4
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (CHECK FOR OPEN IN HYBRID VEHICLE
CONTROL ECU)
No. 1 Motor Temperature
Sensor
HV Control ECU
(a) Disconnect the M10 No. 1 motor temperature sensor
connector.
MMT
HV
MMTG
A092037E01
H17
MMT
MMTG
HV Control ECU Connector
A093719E07
(b) Connect terminals MMT and MMTG of the H17 HV
control ECU connector.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DATA LIST.
(e) Read the MOTOR 1 TEMP value.
OK:
205°C (401°F)
HINT:
If the intelligent tester indicates a temperature of -50°C (58°F), check the connection of the HV control ECU. If it
is connected normally, replace the HV control ECU.
(f) Reconnect the No. 1 motor temperature sensor
connector.
NG
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–193
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR
5
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (CHECK FOR GND SHORT IN WIRE HARNESS)
No. 1 Motor Temperature
Sensor
HV Control ECU
MMT
MMTG
A092038E01
(a) Disconnect the M10 No. 1 motor temperature sensor
connector.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DATA LIST.
(d) Read the MOTOR 1 TEMP value.
OK:
-50°C (-58°F)
(e) Reconnect the No. 1 motor temperature sensor
connector.
HINT:
The No. 1 motor temperature sensor is unavailable as an
individual service part. Therefore, when replacing it, the
hybrid vehicle motor must be replaced.
OK
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE MOTOR
ASSEMBLY
NG
6
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (CHECK FOR GND SHORT IN HYBRID VEHICLE
CONTROL ECU)
(a) Disconnect the H17 HV control ECU connector.
H17
HV Control ECU Connector
A065743E72
No. 1 Motor Temperature
HV Control ECU
Sensor
MMT
MMTG
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DATA LIST.
(d) Read the MOTOR 1 TEMP value.
OK:
-50°C (-58°F)
(e) Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
NG
A092039E01
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
HV
HV–194
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR
HV
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A37258
HV–195
Generator Temperature Sensor Circuit Range /
Performance
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0A38 (INF 257) (see page HV-195).
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A37
258
No. 2 motor temperature sensor
malfunction
•
Hybrid vehicle motor
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
If the information (INF) code 258 is present, replace the hybrid vehicle motor.
HINT:
The No. 2 motor temperature sensor is unavailable as an individual service part. Therefore, when
replacing it, the hybrid vehicle motor must be replaced.
1
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE MOTOR ASSEMBLY
NEXT
COMPLETED
HV
HV–196
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A37260
Generator Temperature Sensor Circuit Range /
Performance
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0A38 (INF 257) (see page HV-195).
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A37
260
No. 2 motor temperature sensor
performance problem
•
•
•
Hybrid vehicle motor
Transaxle fluid leakage
HV transaxle assembly
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK TRANSAXLE FLUID LEVEL
(a) Check if the transaxle is filled with fluid to the specified
level.
OK:
The transaxle is filled with fluid to the specified
level
HINT:
The No. 2 motor temperature sensor is unavailable as an
individual service part. Therefore, when replacing it, the
hybrid vehicle motor must be replaced.
NG
OK
HV
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE MOTOR ASSEMBLY
REPAIR OIL LEAKAGE, OR REPLACE
HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE
HV–197
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A38257
Generator Temperature Sensor Circuit Low
DTC
P0A39259
Generator Temperature Sensor Circuit High
DESCRIPTION
The No. 2 motor temperature sensor detects the temperature of the transaxle fluid. The resistance of the
thermistor installed in the No. 2 motor temperature sensor varies with the changes in the transaxle fluid
temperature. The construction in the No. 2 motor temperature sensor and how it is connected to the HV
control ECU are the same as those of the No. 1 motor temperature sensor (see page HV-187).
Based on the signal provided by the No. 2 motor temperature sensor, the HV control ECU limits the load
to prevent the motor from overheating. Furthermore, the HV control ECU checks the No. 2 motor
temperature sensor for a wiring malfunction and the sensor for a malfunction.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A38
257
GND short in No. 2 motor
temperature sensor circuit
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Hybrid vehicle motor
HV control ECU
P0A39
259
Open or +B short in No. 2 motor
temperature sensor circuit
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Hybrid vehicle motor
HV control ECU
HINT:
After confirming DTC P0A38 (INF 257) or P0A39 (INF 259), confirm MOTOR 2 TEMP in DIAGNOSIS /
OBD/MOBD / HV ECU / DATA LIST using the intelligent tester.
Temperature Displayed
Malfunction
-50°C (-58°F)
Open or +B short circuit
205°C (401°F)
GND short circuit
HV
WIRING DIAGRAM
No. 2 Motor Generator
HV Control ECU
OMT
3
M10
B
30
OMT
H17
OMTG
6
M10
G
29
OMTG
H17
R
No. 2 Motor Temperature
Sensor
A092299E02
HV–198
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (MOTOR 2 TEMP)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DATA LIST.
(e) Read the MOTOR 2 TEMP value.
Result:
Temperature Displayed
Proceed to
-50°C (-58°F)
A
205°C (401°F)
B
-49°C to 204°C (-57°F to 400°F)
C
HINT:
• If there is an open or +B short circuit, the intelligent
tester indicates -50°C (-58°F).
• If there is a GND short circuit, the intelligent tester
indicates 205°C (401°F).
B
C
Go to step 5
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
A
2
HV
INSPECT HYBRID VEHICLE MOTOR ASSEMBLY (CHECK FOR OPEN OR +B SHORT)
No. 2 Motor Temperature
HV Control ECU
Sensor
(a) Disconnect the M10 No. 2 motor temperature sensor
connector.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
OMT
OMTG
A092038E02
(c) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the No. 2
motor temperature sensor connector.
Result:
Wire Harness Side:
M10
OMT (+)
OMTG (-)
No. 2 Motor Temperature Sensor Connector
A092036E03
Tester Connection
Voltage
Proceed to
OMT (M10-3) - OMTG
(M10-6)
Approximately 5 V
A
OMT (M10-3) - OMTG
(M10-6)
9 to 14 V
B
OMT (M10-3) - OMTG
(M10-6)
Approximately 0 V
C
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–199
HINT:
The No. 2 motor temperature sensor is unavailable as an
individual service part. Therefore, when replacing it, the
hybrid vehicle motor must be replaced.
(d) Reconnect the No. 2 motor temperature sensor
connector.
A
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE MOTOR
ASSEMBLY
C
Go to step 4
B
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (CHECK FOR +B SHORT)
(a) Disconnect the H17 HV control ECU connector.
H17
HV Control ECU Connector
A065743E71
Wire Harness Side:
M10
OMT (+)
No. 2 Motor Temperature Sensor Connector
A092036E04
(b) Disconnect the M10 No. 2 motor temperature sensor
connector.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Measure the voltage between the terminal of the No. 2
motor temperature sensor connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
OMT (M10-3) - Body ground
Approximately 0 V
(e) Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
(f) Reconnect the No. 2 motor temperature sensor
connector.
NG
OK
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
HV
HV–200
4
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (CHECK FOR OPEN IN HYBRID VEHICLE
CONTROL ECU)
No. 2 Motor Temperature
Sensor
HV Control ECU
(a) Disconnect the M10 No. 2 motor temperature sensor
connector.
OMT
OMTG
A092037E02
H17
OMTG
OMT
HV Control ECU Connector
A093719E08
HV
(b) Connect terminals OMT and OMTG of the H17 HV
control ECU connector.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DATA LIST.
(e) Read the MOTOR 2 TEMP value.
OK:
205°C (401°F)
HINT:
If the intelligent tester indicates a temperature of -50°C (58°F), check the connection of the HV control ECU. If it
is connected normally, replace the HV control ECU.
(f) Reconnect the No. 2 motor temperature sensor
connector.
NG
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR
5
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (CHECK FOR GND SHORT IN WIRE HARNESS)
No. 2 Motor Temperature
HV Control ECU
Sensor
OMT
OMTG
A092038E02
(a) Disconnect the M10 No. 2 motor temperature sensor
connector.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DATA LIST.
(d) Read the MOTOR 2 TEMP value.
OK:
-50°C (-58°F)
(e) Reconnect the No. 2 motor temperature sensor
connector.
HINT:
The No. 2 motor temperature sensor is unavailable as an
individual service part. Therefore, when replacing it, the
hybrid vehicle motor must be replaced.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
OK
HV–201
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE MOTOR
ASSEMBLY
NG
6
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (CHECK FOR GND SHORT IN HYBRID VEHICLE
CONTROL ECU)
(a) Disconnect the H17 HV control ECU connector.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
H17
HV Control ECU Connector
A065743E72
No. 2 Motor Temperature
HV Control ECU
Sensor
OMT
OMTG
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DATA LIST.
(d) Read the MOTOR 2 TEMP value.
OK:
-50°C (-58°F)
(e) Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
NG
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
A092039E02
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR
HV
HV–202
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A3F243
Drive Motor "A" Position Sensor Circuit
DTC
P0A40500
Drive Motor "A" Position Sensor Circuit Range
/ Performance
DTC
P0A41245
Drive Motor "A" Position Sensor Circuit Low
DESCRIPTION
The motor resolver is a type of sensor that detects the position of the magnetic poles, which are
indispensable for ensuring the highly efficient control of the MG1 and MG2.
The stator of the resolver contains an excitation coil and two detection coils. Because the rotor has an
oval shape, the gap between the stator and the rotor changes as the rotor turns. An alternating current
with a predetermined frequency flows through the excitation coil, and detection coils S and C output
alternating currents in accordance with the position of the sensor rotor.
The HV control ECU detects the absolute position of the rotor in accordance with the phases of detection
coils S and C and the height of their waveform. Furthermore, the CPU calculates the amount of change in
the position within a predetermined length of time, in order to use the resolver as a speed sensor.
Rotor
-S
-C
+C
+S
HV
Excitation
Waveform
+S
+C
-S
S
Output
C Waveform
-C
Excitation Coil
A093727E01
The HV control ECU monitors the output signals of the motor resolver and detects a malfunction.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A3F
243
Interphase short in motor resolver
circuit
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Hybrid vehicle motor
HV control ECU
P0A40
500
Motor resolver output is out of
normal range
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Hybrid vehicle motor
HV control ECU
P0A41
245
Open or short in motor resolver
circuit
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Hybrid vehicle motor
HV control ECU
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU monitors the motor resolver output signal. If the HV control ECU detects output
signals that are out of the normal range or specification, it will conclude that there is a malfunction of the
motor resolver. The HV control ECU will illuminate the MIL and set a DTC.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–203
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A3F (INF 243):
Drive motor "A" position sensor circuit malfunction / Short circuit
between phases
P0A40 (INF 500):
Drive motor "A" position sensor circuit malfunction / Range check
P0A41(INF 245):
Drive motor "A" position sensor circuit malfunction / Circuit
discontinuity or short circuit
Required sensor / components
Motor resolver
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
No other condition
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Motor resolver
Circuit malfunction (interphase shot, open or short), or abnormal
output
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Motor resolver
DTCs P0A3F (INF 243), P0A40 (INF 500) and P0A41 (INF 245) are
not detected
HV
HV–204
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
HV Control ECU
No. 2 Motor Generator
MRF
MRFG
MSN
*
1
M9
4
M9
*
2
M9
5
M9
MSNG
MCS
*
3
M9
6
MCSG M9
*: Shielded
L
34
H17
P
33
H17 MRFG
G
20
H17
R
19
H17 MSNG
Y
32
H17
J12
J/C
W-B
W-B
B
8
W-B
EB1
B
MSN
MCS
31
H17 MCSG
BR
B
MRF
W-B
EF
A092098E01
HV
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - MOTOR
RESOLVER)
(a) Disconnect the H17 HV control ECU connector.
H17
MSN
MRF
MRFG
MSNG HV Control ECU
MCSG Connector
MCS
A065743E73
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
(b) Disconnect the M9 motor resolver connector.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the HV
control ECU connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side:
M9
MRF
MRFG
MSNG
HV–205
MSN
MCS
MCSG
Motor Resolver Connector
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
MRF (H17-34) - Body ground
Below 1 V
MRFG (H17-33) - Body ground
Below 1 V
MSN (H17-20) - Body ground
Below 1 V
MSNG (H17-19) - Body ground
Below 1 V
MCS (H17-32) - Body ground
Below 1 V
MCSG (H17-31) - Body ground
Below 1 V
A092036E05
(e) Turn the power switch OFF.
(f) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
MRF (H17-34) - MRF (M9-1)
Below 1 Ω
MRFG (H17-33) - MRFG (M9-4)
Below 1 Ω
MSN (H17-20) - MSN (M9-2)
Below 1 Ω
MSNG (H17-19) - MSNG (M9-5)
Below 1 Ω
MCS (H17-32) - MCS (M9-3)
Below 1 Ω
MCSG (H17-31) - MCSG (M9-6)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
MRF (H17-34) or MRF (M9-1) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
MRFG (H17-33) or MRFG (M9-4) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
MSN (H17-20) or MSN (M9-2) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
MSNG (H17-19) or MSNG (M9-5) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
MCS (H17-32) or MCS (M9-3) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
MCSG (H17-31) or MCSG (M9-6) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(g) Reconnect the motor resolver connector.
(h) Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
NG
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
HV
HV–206
2
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT MOTOR RESOLVER
Motor Resolver
MSN
MRF
MCS
MCSG
MSNG
MRFG
A092040E01
(a) Disconnect the M9 motor resolver connector.
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the
motor resolver.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
MRF (M9-1) - MRFG (M9-4)
7.65 to 10.2 Ω
MSN (M9-2) - MSNG (M9-5)
12.6 to 16.8 Ω
MCS (M9-3) - MCSG (M9-6)
12.6 to 16.8 Ω
(c) Using a megohmmeter, measure the insulation
resistance between the terminals of the motor resolver.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
MRF (M9-1) - MSN (M9-2)
10 MΩ or higher
MRF (M9-1) - MCS (M9-3)
10 MΩ or higher
MSN (M9-2) - MCS (M9-3)
10 MΩ or higher
MRFG (M9-4) - MSNG (M9-5)
10 MΩ or higher
MRFG (M9-4) - MCSG (M9-6)
10 MΩ or higher
MSNG (M9-5) - MCSG (M9-6)
10 MΩ or higher
Each terminal listed above Transaxle housing
10 MΩ or higher
NG
HV
OK
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE MOTOR
ASSEMBLY
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–207
DTC
P0A4B253
Generator Position Sensor Circuit
DTC
P0A4C513
Generator Position Sensor Circuit Range / Performance
DTC
P0A4D255
Generator Position Sensor Circuit Low
DESCRIPTION
The generator resolver detects the position of the magnetic poles, which are indispensable for ensuring
the highly efficient control of the MG1 and MG2. The construction of the generator resolver and how it is
connected to the HV control ECU are the same as those of the motor resolver (see page HV-200).
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A4B
253
Interphase short in generator
resolver circuit
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Hybrid vehicle generator
HV control ECU
P0A4C
513
Generator resolver output is out
of normal range
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Hybrid vehicle generator
HV control ECU
P0A4D
255
Open or short in generator
resolver circuit
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Hybrid vehicle generator
HV control ECU
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU monitors the generator resolver output signal. If the HV control ECU detects output
signals that are out of the normal range or specification, it will conclude that there is a malfunction of the
generator resolver. The HV control ECU will illuminate the MIL and set a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A4B (INF 253):
Generator position sensor circuit malfunction / Short circuit between
phases
P0A4C (INF 513):
Generator position sensor circuit malfunction / Range check
P0A4D (INF 255):
Generator position sensor circuit malfunction / Circuit discontinuity or
short circuit
Required sensor / components
Generator resolver
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
No other condition
-
HV
HV–208
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Generator resolver
Circuit malfunction (interphase shot, open or short), or abnormal
output
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Generator resolver
DTCs P0A4B (INF 253) P0A4C (INF 513) and P0A4D (INF 255) are
not detected
WIRING DIAGRAM
No. 1 Motor Generator
GRF
GRFG
GSN
HV Control ECU
*
3
M5
6
M5
*
2
M5
5
M5
GSNG
GCS
*
1
M5
4
GCSG M5
27
H17
W
26
H17 GRFG
R
22
H17
G
21
H17 GSNG
Y
23
H17
J12
J/C
B
W-B
W-B
B
8
W-B
EB1
B
GRF
GSN
GCS
24
H17 GCSG
BR
HV
*: Shielded
B
W-B
EF
A092098E02
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–209
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - GENERATOR
RESOLVER)
(a) Disconnect the H17 HV control ECU connector.
H17
GCSG
GRF
GRFG
GSNG HV Control ECU
GSN
Connector
GCS
A065743E74
(b) Disconnect the M5 generator resolver connector.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the HV
control ECU connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side:
M5
GCS
GCSG
GSN
GRF
GRFG
GSNG
Generator Resolver Connector
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
GRF (H17-27) - Body ground
Below 1 V
GRFG (H17-26) - Body ground
Below 1 V
GSN (H17-22) - Body ground
Below 1 V
GSNG (H17-21) - Body ground
Below 1 V
GCS (H17-23) - Body ground
Below 1 V
GCSG (H17-24) - Body ground
Below 1 V
A092036E06
(e) Turn the power switch OFF.
(f) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
GRF (H17-27) - GRF (M5-3)
Below 1 Ω
GRFG (H17-26) - GRFG (M5-6)
Below 1 Ω
GSN (H17-22) - GSN (M5-2)
Below 1 Ω
GSNG (H17-21) - GSNG (M5-5)
Below 1 Ω
GCS (H17-23) - GCS (M5-1)
Below 1 Ω
GCSG (H17-24) - GCSG (M5-4)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
GRF (H17-27) or GRF (M5-3) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
GRFG (H17-26) or GRFG (M5-6) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
GSN (H17-22) or GSN (M5-2) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
GSNG (H17-21) or GSNG (M5-5) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
GCS (H17-23) or GCS (M5-1) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
HV
HV–210
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
GCSG (H17-24) or GCSG (M5-4) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(g) Reconnect the generator resolver connector.
(h) Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
2
INSPECT GENERATOR RESOLVER
Generator Resolver
GSN
GRF
GRFG
HV
GCS
GSNG
GCSG
A092040E02
(a) Disconnect the M5 generator resolver connector.
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the
generator resolver.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
GCS (M5-1) - GCSG (M5-4)
12.6 to 16.8 Ω
GSN (M5-2) - GSNG (M5-5)
12.6 to 16.8 Ω
GRF (M5-3) - GRFG (M5-6)
7.65 to 10.2 Ω
(c) Using a megohmmeter, measure the insulation
resistance between the terminals of the generator
resolver.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
GCS (M5-1) - GSN (M5-2)
10 MΩ or higher
GCS (M5-1) - GRF (M5-3)
10 MΩ or higher
GSN (M5-2) - GRF (M5-3)
10 MΩ or higher
GCSG (M5-4) - GSNG (M5-5)
10 MΩ or higher
GCSG (M5-4) - GRFG (M5-6)
10 MΩ or higher
GSNG (M5-5) - GRFG (M5-6)
10 MΩ or higher
Each terminal listed above Transaxle housing
10 MΩ or higher
NG
OK
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE GENERATOR
ASSEMBLY
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A51174
HV–211
Drive Motor "A" Current Sensor Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The HV control performs self-checks to detect an internal operating malfunction in the ECU.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A51
174
HV control ECU internal error
•
HV control ECU
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
If the information (INF) code is present, replace the HV control ECU.
1
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
(a) Replace the hybrid vehicle control ECU (see page HV543).
NEXT
COMPLETED
HV
HV–212
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A60288
Drive Motor "A" Phase V Current
DTC
P0A60289
Drive Motor "A" Phase V Current
DTC
P0A60290
Drive Motor "A" Phase V Current
DTC
P0A60292
Drive Motor "A" Phase V Current
DTC
P0A60294
Drive Motor "A" Phase V Current
DTC
P0A60501
Drive Motor "A" Phase V Current
DTC
P0A63296
Drive Motor "A" Phase W Current
DTC
P0A63297
Drive Motor "A" Phase W Current
DTC
P0A63298
Drive Motor "A" Phase W Current
DTC
P0A63300
Drive Motor "A" Phase W Current
DTC
P0A63302
Drive Motor "A" Phase W Current
DTC
P0A63502
Drive Motor "A" Phase W Current
HV
DESCRIPTION
See the description of the inverter (see page HV-220).
The motor inverter current sensors detect the amperage that flows through the V and W phase cables
between the inverter and MG1/MG2. The inverter transmits information that is necessary for effecting
control, such as the amperage and voltage, to the HV control ECU.
The HV control ECU monitors the inverter current sensors to detect a malfunction in the sensor system.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–213
It does not detect malfunctions in the high voltage system.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A60
288
Phase V current sub sensor of
motor inverter current sensor
malfunction
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0A60
289
Open in phase V current sub
sensor circuit of motor inverter
current sensor
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0A60
290
Phase V current main sensor of
motor inverter current sensor
malfunction
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0A60
292
Open in phase V current main
sensor circuit of motor inverter
current sensor
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0A60
294
Phase V current main and sub
sensors of motor inverter current
sensor performance problem
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0A60
501
Phase V current main and sub
sensors of motor inverter current
sensor offset malfunction
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0A63
296
Phase W current sub sensor of
motor inverter current sensor
malfunction
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0A63
297
Open in phase W current sub
sensor circuit of motor inverter
current sensor
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0A63
298
Phase W current main sensor of
motor inverter current sensor
malfunction
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0A63
300
Open in phase W current main
sensor circuit of motor inverter
current sensor
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0A63
302
Phase W current main and sub
sensors of motor inverter current
sensor performance problem
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0A63
502
Phase W current main and sub
sensors of motor inverter current
sensor offset malfunction
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU monitors the motor inverter current sensor. If the HV control ECU detects a fault, it
will illuminate the MIL and set a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A60 (INF 288 / 289 / 290 / 292 / 294 / 501):
Motor inverter current sensor / Phase V current sensor malfunction
P0A63 (INF 296 / 297 / 298 / 300 / 302 / 502):
Motor inverter current sensor / Phase W current sensor malfunction
Required sensor / components
Motor inverter current sensor, motor resolver
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
HV
HV–214
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
P0A60 (INF 288 / 289 / 290 / 292 / 294 / 501):
Motor inverter current sensor
DTC P0A60 (INF 288 / 289 / 290 / 292 / 294 / 501) is not detected
P0A63 (INF 296 / 297 / 298 / 300 / 302 / 502):
Motor inverter current sensor
DTC P0A63 (INF 296 / 297 / 298 / 300 / 302 / 502) is not detected
WIRING DIAGRAM
HV Control ECU
Inverter
7
MIVA I10
HV
*
G
30
H15 MIVA
8
MIVB I10
W
21
H15 MIVB
23
MIWA I10
R
29
H15 MIWA
24
MIWB I10
B
20
H15 MIWB
16
GINV I10
Y
*: Shielded
J5
J/C
*
A
23
H15 GINV
A
IK
A092099E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
1
HV–215
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - INVERTER)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Disconnect the H15 HV control ECU connector.
(d) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
H15
MIWB
MIWA
MIVA
HV Control ECU Connector
GINV
MIVB
A065744E27
(e) Disconnect the I10 inverter connector.
(f) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(g) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the HV
control ECU connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side:
I10
MIVA MIVB
GINV
I10
MIWA
Inverter Connector
MIWB
A092041E07
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
MIVA (H15-30) - Body ground
Below 1 V
MIVB (H15-21) - Body ground
Below 1 V
MIWA (H15-29) - Body ground
Below 1 V
MIWB (H15-20) - Body ground
Below 1 V
GINV (H15-23) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(h) Turn the power switch OFF.
(i) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
MIVA (H15-30) - MIVA (I10-7)
Below 1 Ω
MIVB (H15-21) - MIVB (I10-8)
Below 1 Ω
MIWA (H15-29) - MIWA (I10-23)
Below 1 Ω
MIWB (H15-20) - MIWB (I10-24)
Below 1 Ω
GINV (H15-23) - GINV (I10-16)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
HV
HV–216
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
MIVA (H15-30) or MIVA (I10-7) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
MIVB (H15-21) or MIVB (I10-8) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
MIWA (H15-29) or MIWA (I10-23) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
MIWB (H15-20) or MIWB (I10-24) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
GINV (H15-23) or GINV (I10-16) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(j)
(k)
(l)
(m)
Reconnect the inverter connector.
Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
HV
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A72326
Generator Phase V Current
DTC
P0A72327
Generator Phase V Current
DTC
P0A72328
Generator Phase V Current
DTC
P0A72330
Generator Phase V Current
DTC
P0A72333
Generator Phase V Current
DTC
P0A72515
Generator Phase V Current
DTC
P0A75334
Generator Phase W Current
DTC
P0A75335
Generator Phase W Current
DTC
P0A75336
Generator Phase W Current
DTC
P0A75338
Generator Phase W Current
DTC
P0A75341
Generator Phase W Current
DTC
P0A75516
Generator Phase W Current
HV–217
HV
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0A60 (INF 288) (see page HV-210).
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A72
326
Phase V current sub sensor of
generator inverter current sensor
malfunction
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
HV–218
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A72
327
Open in phase V current sub
sensor circuit of generator
inverter current sensor
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0A72
328
Phase V current main sensor of
generator inverter current sensor
malfunction
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0A72
330
Open in phase V current main
sensor circuit of generator
inverter current sensor
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0A72
333
Phase V current main and sub
sensors of generator inverter
current sensor performance
problem
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0A72
515
Phase V current main and sub
sensors of generator inverter
current sensor offset malfunction
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0A75
334
Phase W current sub sensor of
generator inverter current sensor
malfunction
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0A75
335
Open in phase W current sub
sensor circuit of generator
inverter current sensor
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0A75
336
Phase W current main sensor of
generator inverter current sensor
malfunction
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0A75
338
Open in phase W current main
sensor circuit of generator
inverter current sensor
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0A75
341
Phase W current main and sub
sensors of generator inverter
current sensor performance
problem
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0A75
516
Phase W current main and sub
sensors of generator inverter
current sensor offset malfunction
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
HV
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU monitors the generator inverter current sensor. If the HV control ECU detects a fault,
it will illuminate the MIL and set a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A72 (INF 326 / 327 / 328 / 330 / 333 / 515):
Generator inverter current sensor / Phase V current sensor
malfunction
P0A75 (INF 334 / 335 / 336 / 338 / 341 / 516):
Generator inverter current sensor / Phase W current sensor
malfunction
Required sensor / components
Generator inverter current sensor, generator resolver
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–219
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
P0A72 (INF 326 / 327 / 328 / 330 / 333 / 515):
Generator inverter current sensor
DTC P0A72 (INF 326 / 327 / 328 / 330 / 333 / 515) is not detected
P0A75 (INF 334 / 335 / 336 / 338 / 341 / 516):
Generator inverter current sensor
DTC P0A75 (INF 334 / 335 / 336 / 338 / 341 / 516) is not detected
WIRING DIAGRAM
HV Control ECU
Inverter
GIVA
*
W
2
I10
34
H15 GIVA
3
GIVB I10
B
33
H15 GIVB
18
GIWA I10
R
32
H15 GIWA
19
GIWB I10
G
31
H15 GIWB
16
GINV I10
Y
*: Shielded
J5
J/C
*
A
23
H15 GINV
A
HV
IK
A092099E03
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - INVERTER)
NOTICE:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
HV–220
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Disconnect the H15 HV control ECU connector.
(d) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
H15
GIVA
GINV
GIVB
GIWA
GIWB
HV Control ECU Connector
A065744E44
Wire Harness Side
I10
Inverter Connector
GIVB
GIVA
GINV
I10
HV
GIWA
GIWB
A092041E31
(e) Disconnect the I10 inverter connector.
(f) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(g) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the HV
control ECU connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
GIVA (H15-34) - Body ground
Below 1 V
GIVB (H15-33) - Body ground
Below 1 V
GIWA (H15-32) - Body ground
Below 1 V
GIWB (H15-31) - Body ground
Below 1 V
GINV (H15-23) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(h) Turn the power switch OFF.
(i) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
GIVA (H15-34) - GIVA (I10-2)
Below 1 Ω
GIVB (H15-33) - GIVB (I10-3)
Below 1 Ω
GIWA (H15-32) - GIWA (I10-18)
Below 1 Ω
GIWB (H15-31) - GIWB (I10-19)
Below 1 Ω
GINV (H15-23) - GINV (I10-16)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
GIVA (H15-34) or GIVA (I10-2) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
GIVB (H15-33) or GIVB (I10-3) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
GIWA (H15-32) or GIWA (I10-18) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
GIWB (H15-31) or GIWB (I10-19) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
GINV (H15-23) or GINV (I10-16) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(j)
(k)
(l)
(m)
HV–221
Reconnect the inverter connector.
Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
HV
HV–222
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A78266
Drive Motor "A" Inverter Performance
DTC
P0A78267
Drive Motor "A" Inverter Performance
DESCRIPTION
The inverter converts the high-voltage direct current of the HV battery and the alternating current for the
MG1/MG2. The inverter contains a three-phase bridge circuit, which consists of 6 power transistors each
for the MG1 and the MG2, in order to convert the direct current and the three-phase alternating current.
The HV control ECU controls the actuation of the power transistors.
The inverter transmits information that is necessary for effecting control, such as the amperage and
voltage, to the HV control ECU.
HV
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
MG1
MG2
U V W
U V W
Amperage
Sensor
HV–223
Amperage
Sensor
Power
Transistor
HV
Control
ECU
IPM for Driving
Interlock Switch
HV
Inverter
IPM for Boosting
DC / DC
Converter
Reactor
A/C Inverter
Boost
Converter
Inverter with Converter Assembly
HV Battery
A093740E02
HV–224
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
The HV control ECU uses a voltage sensor, which has been built into the inverter, to detect the high
voltage after boost control.
Output
Voltage (V)
5.0
4.0
3.0
2.0
1.0
0
100 200 300 400 500 600 700
High-Voltage (V)
A125422E01
The inverter voltage sensor outputs a voltage that varies between 0 and 5 V in accordance with the
changes in the high voltage. The higher the high voltage, the higher the output voltage, and the lower the
high voltage, the lower the output voltage.
The HV control ECU monitors the inverter voltage and detects a malfunction.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A78
266
Open or GND short in inverter
voltage (VH) sensor circuit
•
•
•
P0A78
267
+B short in inverter voltage (VH)
sensor circuit
•
•
•
HV
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
HV control ECU
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
HV control ECU
HINT:
After confirming DTC P0A78 (INF 266 or 267), confirm VH in DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD / HV ECU / DATA
LIST using the intelligent tester.
Voltage Displayed
Malfunction
765 V
+B short circuit
0V
Open or GND short circuit
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU monitors the inverter voltage (VH) sensor circuit. If the HV control ECU detects an
open or short malfunction of the VH sensor circuit, the HV control ECU illuminates the MIL and sets a
DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A78 (INF 266 / 267): Motor inverter / VH malfunction
Required sensor / components
Motor inverter
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
1 driving cycle
Sequence of operation
None
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–225
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Voltage (VH) sensor circuit
Open or short
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Motor inverter
DTC P0A78 (INF 266 / 267) is not detected
WIRING DIAGRAM
(Shielded)
Inverter
HV Control ECU
12
I10
Y
16
GINV I10
Y
VH
26
H15 VH
(Shielded)
J5
J/C
A
23
H15 GINV
A
IK
A092100E03
HV
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV ECU)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTC P0A1D is output
HV–226
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
YES
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
NO
2
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (VH)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DATA LIST.
(e) Read the VH value.
Result:
Voltage Displayed
Proceed to
765 V
A
0V
B
1 to 764 V
C
HINT:
• If there is a +B short circuit, the intelligent tester indicates
765 V.
• If there is an open or GND short circuit, the intelligent
tester indicates 0 V.
B
C
Go to step 5
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
A
HV
3
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (CHECK FOR +B SHORT IN WIRE HARNESS)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–227
(d) Disconnect the I10 inverter connector.
Wire Harness Side
I10
VH
GINV
I10
Inverter Connector
A092041E35
Inverter Voltage Sensor
HV Control ECU
VH
GINV
A125426E01
(e) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(f) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DATA LIST.
(g) Read the VH value.
Standard voltage:
0V
(h) Turn the power switch OFF.
(i) Reconnect the inverter connector.
(j) Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
(k) Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
NG
4
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (CHECK FOR +B SHORT IN HYBRID VEHICLE
CONTROL ECU)
(a) Disconnect the H15 HV control ECU connector.
H15
HV Control
ECU Connector VH
GINV
A065744E45
HV
HV–228
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Inverter Voltage
Sensor
HV Control ECU
VH
GINV
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DATA LIST.
(d) Read the VH value.
Standard voltage:
0V
(e) Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
NG
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
A126232E05
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR
5
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - INVERTER)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
(d) Disconnect the H15 HV control ECU connector.
HV
H15
HV Control
ECU Connector VH
GINV
A065744E45
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Wire Harness Side
I10
(e) Disconnect the I10 inverter connector.
(f) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
VH
Inverter Connector
A092041E35
Specified Condition
VH (H15-26) - VH (I10-12)
Below 1 Ω
GINV (H15-23) - GINV (I10-16)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
GINV
I10
HV–229
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VH (H15-26) or VH (I10-12) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
GINV (H15-23) or GINV (I10-16) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(g)
(h)
(i)
(j)
Reconnect the inverter connector.
Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
6
INSPECT HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU (VH VOLTAGE)
(a) Turn the power switch ON (READY).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(b) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the H15
HV control ECU connector.
Standard voltage
H15
VH (+)
GINV (-)
HV Control ECU Connector
A124045E16
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VH (H15-26) - GINV (H15-23)
1.6 to 3.8 V
NG
OK
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
HV
HV–230
DTC
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
P0A78272
Drive Motor "A" Inverter Performance
DESCRIPTION
See the description of the inverter (see page HV-220).
The inverter switches the power transistors ON and OFF in accordance with power transistor actuation
signals received from the HV control ECU, in order to change the direction of the current that flows
through the MG1/MG2. Also, the inverter regulates the duration of the switching time through PWM (Pulse
Width Modulation) control, in order to control the voltage that is applied to the MG1/MG2.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A78
272
Abnormality in motor PWM circuit
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU monitors the motor PWM circuit. If there is an error in the power transistor actuation
signals which are transmitted to the inverter, the HV control ECU interprets this as a malfunction of the
motor PWM circuit.
The HV control ECU illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A78 (INF 272): Motor PWM malfunction
Required sensor / components
Motor inverter
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
1 driving cycle
Sequence of operation
None
HV
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Power transistor actuation signal
Abnormal
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Motor inverter
DTC P0A78 (INF 272) is not detected
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–231
WIRING DIAGRAM
Inverter
HV Control ECU
(Shielded)
11
MWU I10
R
11
H15 MWU
9
MUU I10
B
9
H15 MUU
10
MVU I10
W
10
H15 MVU
A
J5
J/C
IK
A092101E04
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV ECU)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTC P0A1D is output
YES
NO
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
HV
HV–232
2
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - INVERTER)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Disconnect the H15 HV control ECU connector.
(d) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
H15
MUU
MVU
MWU
HV Control
ECU Connector
A065744E46
Wire Harness Side:
I10
HV
MUU
MVU
MWU
(e) Disconnect the I10 inverter connector.
(f) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
MUU (H15-9) - MUU (I10-9)
Below 1 Ω
MVU (H15-10) - MVU (I10-10)
Below 1 Ω
MWU (H15-11) - MWU (I10-11)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
I10
Inverter Connector
A092041E36
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
MUU (H15-9) or MUU (I10-9) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
MVU (H15-10) or MVU (I10-10) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
MWU (H15-11) or MWU (I10-11) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(g)
(h)
(i)
(j)
Reconnect the inverter connector.
Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A78278
Drive Motor "A" Inverter Performance
DTC
P0A78280
Drive Motor "A" Inverter Performance
HV–233
DESCRIPTION
See the description of the inverter (see page HV-220).
If the motor inverter detects a circuit malfunction or over-voltage, the inverter transmits this information to
the OVH terminal of the HV control ECU via the motor inverter over-voltage signal line.
The HV control ECU monitors the motor inverter over-voltage signal line to detect the malfunction.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A78
278
+B short in motor inverter overvoltage (OVH) signal circuit
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0A78
280
Open or GND short in motor
inverter over-voltage (OVH)
signal circuit
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU monitors the motor inverter over-voltage (OVH) signal line. If the HV control ECU
detects an open or short malfunction of the OVH signal circuit, the HV control ECU illuminates the MIL
and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A78 (INF 278 / 280): Motor inverter / Motor inverter Sinv detection
Required sensor / components
Motor inverter
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
1 driving cycle
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Over-voltage signal circuit
Open or short
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Motor inverter
DTC P0A78 (INF 278 / 280) is not detected
HV
HV–234
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
HV Control ECU
Inverter
28
I10
OVH
22
H15 OVH
BR
(Shielded)
16
GINV I10
23
H15 GINV
Y
A
J5
J/C
IK
A092102E06
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
HV
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID CONTROL ECU - INVERTER)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Disconnect the H15 HV control ECU connector.
(d) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
H15
GINV
OVH
HV Control ECU Connector
A065744E47
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Wire Harness Side:
I10
GINV
I10
Inverter Connector
OVH
A092041E37
HV–235
(e) Disconnect the I10 inverter connector.
(f) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(g) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the HV
control ECU connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
OVH (H15-22) - Body ground
Below 1 V
GINV (H15-23) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(h) Turn the power switch OFF.
(i) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
OVH (H15-22) - OVH (I10-28)
Below 1 Ω
GINV (H15-23) - GINV (I10-16)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
OVH (H15-22) or OVH (I10-28) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
GINV (H15-23) or GINV (I10-16) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(j)
(k)
(l)
(m)
Reconnect the inverter connector.
Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
HV
HV–236
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A78279
Drive Motor "A" Inverter Performance
DTC
P0A78503
Drive Motor "A" Inverter Performance
DTC
P0A78504
Drive Motor "A" Inverter Performance
DESCRIPTION
See the description of the inverter (see page HV-220).
If the motor inverter detects a circuit malfunction or over-voltage, the inverter transmits this information to
the OVH terminal of the HV control ECU via the motor inverter over-voltage signal line.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A78
279
Motor inverter over-voltage
(OVH) signal detection (overvoltage by inverter assembly
malfunction)
•
•
•
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
HV transaxle assembly
Hybrid vehicle motor
Hybrid vehicle generator
HV control ECU
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0A78
503
Motor inverter over-voltage
(OVH) signal detection (overvoltage by HV control ECU
malfunction)
•
•
•
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
HV transaxle assembly
Hybrid vehicle motor
Hybrid vehicle generator
HV control ECU
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0A78
504
Motor inverter over-voltage
(OVH) signal detection (overvoltage by HV transaxle assembly
malfunction)
•
•
•
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
HV transaxle assembly
Hybrid vehicle motor
Hybrid vehicle generator
HV control ECU
Inverter with converter
assembly
HV
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
If the motor inverter detects over-voltage, it transmits an over-voltage signal to the HV control ECU. Upon
receiving this signal, the HV control ECU illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A78 (INF 279 / 503 / 504): Motor inverter / OVH detection over
voltage
Required sensor / components
Motor inverter
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
No other condition
-
HV–237
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Motor inverter
Over-voltage
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Motor inverter
DTC P0A78 (INF 279 / 503 / 504) is not detected
WIRING DIAGRAM
Inverter
(Shielded)
U
V
MG1
W
U
V
MG2
W
IPM for
Driving
HV Control ECU
4
GUU I10
B
15
H15 GUU
5
GVU I10
G
14
H15 GVU
6
I10
GWU
Y
13
H15 GWU
(Shielded)
9
MUU I10
B
9
H15 MUU
10
MVU I10
W
10
H15 MVU
11
MWU I10
R
11
H15 MWU
16
I10
GINV
Y
23
H15 GINV
A
A
HV
J5
J/C
IK
A092103E03
HV–238
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
CONFIRM INFORMATION (EXCLUSIVE INFO 3)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Select DTC P0A78 to display its freeze frame data.
(f) Select the item that has INF code 279, 503, or 504 from
among INFORMATION 1 to 5, and press ENTER.
(g) Read EXCLUSIVE INFO 3.
Result:
-32 to 32 (during driving without battery power)
HINT:
If the value is inside the range shown above, DTCs other than
P0A78 (INF 279, 503 and 504) have been detected as well.
Perform troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
HV
YES
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
NO
2
CHECK CONNECTION CONDITION OF HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU CONNECTOR
(LOOSENESS AND POOR CONTACT)
(a) Check the connection condition of all the connectors at
the HV control ECU.
OK:
Connectors have been connected securely and
there is no poor connection.
NG
HV Control ECU Connector
A093719E09
OK
CONNECT SECURELY
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
3
HV–239
CHECK CONNECTION CONDITION OF INVERTER CONNECTOR (LOOSENESS AND
POOR CONTACT)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the service
plug grip removed could cause malfunction. Therefore,
never turn the power switch ON (READY) in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
(d) Check the connection condition of the I9 and I10 inverter
connectors.
OK:
Connectors have been connected securely and
there is no poor connection.
(e) Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
(f) Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
I10
I9
Inverter Connector
NG
CONNECT SECURELY
A092044E04
OK
4
CONFIRM INFORMATION (EXCLUSIVE INFO 4)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when turning
the power switch ON (IG) with both the service plug grip and
inverter cover removed.
(c) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Select DTC P0A78 to display its freeze frame data.
(f) Select the item that has INF code 279, 503, or 504 from
among INFORMATION 1 to 5, and press ENTER.
(g) Read EXCLUSIVE INFO 4.
Result
Displayed in Exclusive Information 4
Proceed to
-127 to -120, -95 to -88, -63 to -56, -31 to -24, 1 to 8, 33 to 40, 65 to
72, 97 to 104
A
-119 to -112, -87 to -80, -55 to -48, -23 to -16, 9 to 16, 41 to 48, 73 to
80, 105 to 112
B
-111 to -104, -79 to -72, -47 to -40, -15 to -8, 17 to 24, 49 to 56, 81 to
88, 113 to 120
C
-103 to -96, -71 to -64, -39 to -32, -7 to 0, 25 to 32, 57 to 64, 89 to 96,
121 to 127
D
HV
HV–240
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
B
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
C
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
D
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE
ASSEMBLY
A
5
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV ECU)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when turning
the power switch ON (IG) with both the service plug grip and
inverter cover removed.
(c) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result: DTCs listed in the table below are output
HV
DTC No.
INF Code
Detection Item
See Page
P0A78
266
Drive Motor "A" Inverter
Performance
HV-220
P0A94
558 or 560
DC / DC Converter Performance
HV-389
P0A94
588
DC / DC Converter Performance
HV-409
P0A94
589
DC / DC Converter Performance
HV-412
P0ADB
227
Hybrid Battery Positive Contactor
Control Circuit Low
HV-439
P0ADF
229
Hybrid Battery Negative
Contactor Control Circuit Low
HV-441
P3000
125
HV Battery Malfunction
HV-466
P3004
131
Power Cable Malfunction
HV-470
YES
GO TO THE PAGE NUMBER SHOWN IN THE
TABLE ABOVE
NO
6
INSPECT HYBRID VEHICLE MOTOR ASSEMBLY
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the service
plug grip removed could cause malfunction. Therefore,
never turn the power switch ON (READY) in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Hybrid Vehicle Motor:
I14
U
V
W
A092045E03
HV–241
(d) Disconnect the three-phase alternating current cable for
the hybrid vehicle motor from the inverter.
(e) Using a milliohm meter, measure the resistance between
the three-phase alternating current cable terminals of the
hybrid vehicle motor.
NOTICE:
If the motor temperature is too high, the resistance varies
considerably, which hinders determining malfunction.
Therefore, measure the resistance at a minimum 8 hours
after the vehicle has been stopped.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition*
U (I14-1) - V (I14-2)
Below 135 mΩ at 20°C
V (I14-2) - W (I14-3)
Below 135 mΩ at 20°C
W (I14-3) - U (I14-1)
Below 135 mΩ at 20°C
*: Apply the formula given below to correct the resistance.
R20 = Rt / {1 + 0.00393 x (T - 20)}
R20: Resistance converted to 20°C (mΩ)
Rt: Resistance between measured lines (mΩ)
T: Ambient air temperature during measurement (°C)
(f) Calculate the difference between the maximum and
minimum resistance between terminals U - V, V - W, and
W - U.
Standard resistance:
Below 2 mΩ
(g) Using a megohmmeter, measure the insulation
resistance between the three-phase alternating current
cable terminals of the hybrid vehicle motor and the body
ground.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
U (I14-1) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
V (I14-2) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
W (I14-3) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
(h) Reconnect the three-phase alternating current cable for
the hybrid vehicle motor.
NG
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE MOTOR
ASSEMBLY
OK
7
INSPECT HYBRID VEHICLE GENERATOR ASSEMBLY
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Check that the service plug grip and inverter cover have
been removed.
HV
HV–242
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Hybrid Vehicle Generator:
I15
V
W
U
A092046E03
(b) Disconnect the three-phase alternating current cable for
the hybrid vehicle generator from the inverter.
(c) Using a milliohm meter, measure the resistance between
the three-phase alternating current cable terminals of the
hybrid vehicle generator.
NOTICE:
If the generator temperature is too high, the resistance
varies considerably, which hinders determining
malfunction. Therefore, measure the resistance at a
minimum 8 hours after the vehicle has been stopped.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition*
U (I15-1) - V (I15-2)
Below 109 mΩ at 20°C
V (I15-2) - W (I15-3)
Below 109 mΩ at 20°C
W (I15-3) - U (I15-1)
Below 109 mΩ at 20°C
*: Apply the formula given below to correct the resistance.
R20 = Rt / {1 + 0.00393 x (T - 20)}
R20: Resistance converted to 20°C (mΩ)
Rt: Resistance between measured lines (mΩ)
T: Ambient air temperature during measurement (°C)
(d) Calculate the difference between the maximum and
minimum resistance between terminals U - V, V - W, and
W - U.
Standard resistance:
Below 2 mΩ
(e) Using a megohmmeter, measure the insulation
resistance between the three-phase alternating current
cable terminals of the hybrid vehicle generator and the
body ground.
Standard resistance
HV
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
U (I15-1) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
V (I15-2) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
W (I15-3) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
(f)
Reconnect the three-phase alternating current cable for
the hybrid vehicle generator.
NG
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE GENERATOR
ASSEMBLY
OK
8
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (INVERTER STOP)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Check that the service plug grip and inverter cover have
been removed.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–243
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when turning
the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug grip and
inverter cover removed.
(d) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(e) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / ACTIVE TEST.
(f) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the
inverter connector while effecting INVERTER STOP.
Standard voltage
I10
GUU GVU GWU MUU MVU MWU
I10
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
MUU (I10-9) - GINV (I10-16)
12 to 16 V
MVU (I10-10) - GINV (I10-16)
12 to 16 V
MWU (I10-11) - GINV (I10-16)
12 to 16 V
GUU (I10-4) - GINV (I10-16)
12 to 16 V
GVU (I10-5) - GINV (I10-16)
12 to 16 V
GWU (I10-6) - GINV (I10-16)
12 to 16 V
(g) Turn the power switch OFF.
GINV
Inverter Connector
A093730E07
OK
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
AND INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
NG
9
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (INVERTER STOP)
I10
GUU GVU GWU MUU MVU MWU
I10
GINV
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Check that the service plug grip and inverter cover have
been removed.
(b) Disconnect the I10 inverter connector.
(c) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(e) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(f) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / ACTIVE TEST.
(g) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the
inverter connector while effecting INVERTER STOP.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Inverter Connector
A093731E05
Specified Condition
MUU (I10-9) - GINV (I10-16)
14 to 16 V
MVU (I10-10) - GINV (I10-16)
14 to 16 V
MWU (I10-11) - GINV (I10-16)
14 to 16 V
GUU (I10-4) - GINV (I10-16)
14 to 16 V
GVU (I10-5) - GINV (I10-16)
14 to 16 V
GWU (I10-6) - GINV (I10-16)
14 to 16 V
HV
HV–244
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
(h)
(i)
(j)
(k)
Turn the power switch OFF.
Reconnect the inverter connector.
Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
OK
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
HV
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A78282
HV–245
Drive Motor "A" Inverter Performance
DESCRIPTION
See the description of the inverter (see page HV-220).
If the motor inverter detects a circuit malfunction or over-voltage, the inverter transmits this information to
the OVH terminal of the HV control ECU via the motor inverter over-voltage signal line.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A78
282
Motor inverter over voltage (OVH)
signal detection (circuit
malfunction)
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
If the motor inverter detects a circuit malfunction, it transmits a motor inverter over-voltage signal to the
HV control ECU. Upon receiving this signal, the HV control ECU illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A78 (INF 282): Motor inverter / OVH detection circuit malfunction
Required sensor / components
Motor inverter
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
No other condition
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Motor inverter
Circuit malfunction
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Motor inverter
DTC P0A78 (INF 282) is not detected
HV
HV–246
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
B
F15
Fusible
1 BE1 Link Block
Assembly
B
1
120 A
MAIN
L
A
W
1 3M
Inverter
J3
J/C
A
1
I9
L
2
I9 GND1
O
1 3A 1 3K
4 3J
2 3J
W-B
1
60A
P/I
20A
HEV
HV Control ECU
IGCT
2
Auxiliary
Battery
IGCT
Engine Room Relay Block
4
H16 MREL
3 3J
W-B
EE
EF
A092104E02
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HV
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV ECU)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result: DTC listed in table below is output
DTC No.
INF Code
Detection Item
See Page
P0A78
278 or 280
Drive Motor "A" Inverter
performance
HV-231
YES
NO
GO TO THE PAGE NUMBER SHOWN IN THE
TABLE ABOVE
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
2
HV–247
CHECK CONNECTION CONDITION OF INVERTER CONNECTOR (LOOSENESS AND
POOR CONTACT)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the service
plug grip removed could cause malfunction. Therefore,
never turn the power switch ON (READY) in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
(d) Check the connection condition of the I9 and I10 inverter
connectors.
OK:
Connectors have been connected securely and
there is no poor connection.
(e) Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
(f) Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
I10
I9
Inverter Connector
NG
CONNECT SECURELY
A092044E05
OK
3
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV ECU)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when turning
the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug grip and
inverter cover removed.
(c) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTCs P0A78 (INF 282, 286) and P0A7A (INF 324)
(inverter circuit malfunction) are output
NO
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
YES
4
INSPECT INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY (IGCT VOLTAGE)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
HV
HV–248
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the service
plug grip removed could cause malfunction. Therefore,
never turn the power switch ON (READY) in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when turning
the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug grip and
inverter cover removed.
(e) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the
inverter connector.
Standard voltage
I9
Inverter Connector
GND1(-)
IGCT (+)
A093729E03
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
IGCT (I9-1) - GND1 (I9-2)
8 V or more
(f) Turn the power switch OFF.
(g) Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
(h) Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
HV
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A78283
Drive Motor "A" Inverter Performance
DTC
P0A78285
Drive Motor "A" Inverter Performance
HV–249
DESCRIPTION
See the description of the inverter (see page HV-220).
If the motor inverter has a circuit malfunction, internal short, or overheats, the inverter transmits this
information to the MFIV terminal of the HV control ECU via the motor inverter fail signal line.
The HV control ECU monitors the motor inverter fail signal line and detects a malfunction.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A78
283
+B short in motor inverter fail
(MFIV) signal circuit
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0A78
285
Open or GND short in motor
inverter fail (MFIV) signal circuit
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU monitors the motor inverter fail (MFIV) signal line. If the HV control ECU detects an
open or short malfunction of the MFIV signal circuit, the HV control ECU illuminates the MIL and sets a
DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A78 (INF 283 / 285): Motor inverter/Motor inverter Finv detection
Required sensor / components
Motor inverter
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
1 driving cycle
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Motor inverter fail signal circuit
Open or short
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Motor inverter
DTC P0A78 (INF 283 / 285) is not detected
HV
HV–250
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
HV Control ECU
Inverter
MFIV
27
I10
18
H15 MFIV
G
(Shielded)
16
GINV I10
23
H15 GINV
Y
A
J5
J/C
IK
A092102E07
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
HV
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - INVERTER)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the service
plug grip removed could cause malfunction. Therefore,
never turn the power switch ON (READY) in this state.
(c) Disconnect the H15 HV control ECU connector.
(d) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
H15
HV Control
ECU Connector
MFIV
GINV
A065744E48
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Wire Harness Side:
I10
GINV
I10
Inverter Connector
MFIV
A092041E38
HV–251
(e) Disconnect the I10 inverter connector.
(f) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when turning
the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug grip and
inverter cover removed.
(g) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the HV
control ECU connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
MFIV (H15-18) - Body ground
Below 1 V
GINV (H15-23) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(h) Turn the power switch OFF.
(i) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
MFIV (H15-18) - MFIV (I10-27)
Below 1Ω
GINV (H15-23) - GINV (I10-16)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
MFIV (H15-18) or MFIV (I10-27) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
GINV (H15-23) or GINV (I10-16) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(j)
(k)
(l)
(m)
Reconnect the inverter connector.
Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
HV
HV–252
DTC
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
P0A78284
Drive Motor "A" Inverter Performance
DESCRIPTION
See the description of the inverter (see page HV-220).
If the motor inverter has a circuit malfunction, internal short, or overheats, the inverter transmits that
information to the MFIV terminal of the HV control ECU via the motor inverter fail signal line.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A78
284
Motor inverter fail (MFIV) signal
detection (inverter overheating)
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter cooling system
Water pump with motor
assembly
Cooling fan motor
No. 2 cooling fan motor
HV transaxle assembly
Hybrid vehicle motor
HV control ECU
Inverter with converter
assembly
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
If the motor inverter overheats, it transmits an inverter fail signal to the HV control ECU. Upon receiving
this signal, the HV control ECU illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
HV
Related DTCs
P0A78 (INF 284): Motor inverter / MFIV detection over heat
Required sensor / components
Motor inverter
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
No other condition
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Motor inverter
Overheated
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Motor inverter
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0A78 (INF 279) (see page HV-235).
DTC P0A78 (INF 284) is not detected
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–253
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV ECU)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTCs listed in the table below are output
DTC No.
Relevant Diagnosis
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
P0A2B, P0A2C or P0A2D
Drive Motor "A" Temperature Sensor Circuit System
P0A37, P0A38 or P0A39
Generator Temperature Sensor Circuit System
P0A3F, P0A40 or P0A41
Drive Motor "A" Position Sensor Circuit System
P0A4B, P0A4C or P0A4D
Generator Position Sensor Circuit System
P0A60 or P0A63
Drive Motor "A" Current Sensor Circuit System
P0A72 or P0A75
Generator Current Sensor Circuit System
P0A78
Drive Motor "A" Inverter Performance
P0A7A
Generator Inverter Performance
P0A90
Drive Motor "A" Performance
P0A92
Hybrid Generator Performance
P0A93
Inverter Cooling System Malfunction
P0A94
DC / DC Converter Malfunction
P0AA1, P0AA4, P0AE0, P0AE6, P0AE7, P0ADB or P0ADF
System Main Relay Circuit System
P0AA6, P3004
High Voltage System
P0AEE
Motor Inverter Temperature Sensor Malfunction
P3000
HV Battery System Malfunction
P3110
Integration Relay Malfunction
P3221
Generator Inverter Temperature Sensor Circuit System
P3226
DC / DC Boost Converter Temperature Sensor Circuit System
YES
NO
GO TO DTC CHART. FIND PAGE NUMBER
TO PROCEED TO DIAGNOSTIC
TROUBLESHOOTING FLOWCHART
HV
HV–254
2
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK QUANTITY OF HV COOLANT
(a) Check that there is a sufficient amount of coolant for the
inverter.
OK:
There is a sufficient amount of coolant for the
inverter
NG
ADD HV COOLANT
OK
3
CHECK COOLANT HOSE
(a) Check that the hoses of the cooling system are not bent
or clogged (refer to the cooling system [see page HV346]).
OK:
The hoses of the cooling system are not bent or
clogged
NG
CORRECT TO NORMAL CONDITION
OK
4
CHECK CONNECTION CONDITION OF WATER PUMP CONNECTOR (LOOSENESS AND
POOR CONTACT)
(a) Check the connection condition of the water pump
connector.
OK:
Connector has been connected securely and there
is no poor connection.
HV
NG
CONNECT SECURELY
A090415E04
OK
5
CHECK WATER PUMP WITH MOTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Check the operation of the water pump.
OK:
Coolant is sloshing in the reservoir tank
NG
REPLACE WATER PUMP WITH MOTOR
ASSEMBLY
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–255
OK
6
CHECK CONNECTION CONDITION OF COOLING FAN MOTOR CONNECTOR
(LOOSENESS AND POOR CONTACT)
(a) Check the connection condition of the cooling fan motor
connectors.
OK:
Connectors have been connected securely and
there is no poor connection.
NG
CONNECT SECURELY
A090546E01
OK
7
INSPECT COOLING FAN MOTOR
(a) Inspect the cooling fan motor (see page CO-5).
NG
REPLACE COOLING FAN MOTOR AND ADD
ENGINE COOLANT
OK
8
INSPECT NO. 2 COOLING FAN MOTOR
(a) Inspect the No. 2 cooling fan motor (see page CO-5).
NG
REPLACE NO. 2 COOLING FAN MOTOR AND
ADD ENGINE COOLANT
OK
9
CHECK CONNECTION CONDITION OF HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU CONNECTOR
(LOOSENESS AND POOR CONTACT)
(a) Check the connection condition of all the connectors at
the HV control ECU.
OK:
Connectors have been connected securely and
there is no poor connection.
NG
HV Control ECU Connector
A093719E10
OK
CONNECT SECURELY
HV
HV–256
10
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK CONNECTION CONDITION OF INVERTER CONNECTOR (LOOSENESS AND
POOR CONTACT)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
(d) Check the connection condition of the I9 and I10 inverter
connectors.
OK:
Connectors have been connected securely and
there is no poor connection.
(e) Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
(f) Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
I10
I9
Inverter Connector
NG
CONNECT SECURELY
A092044E05
OK
11
CONFIRM INFORMATION (EXCLUSIVE INFO 4)
HV
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when turning
the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug grip and
inverter cover removed.
(c) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Select DTC P0A78 to display its freeze frame data.
(f) Select the item that has INF code 284 from among
INFORMATION 1 to 5, and press ENTER.
(g) Read EXCLUSIVE INFO 4.
Result:
Displayed in Exclusive Information 4
Proceed to
-127 to -120, -95 to -88, -63 to -56, -31 to -24, 1 to 8, 33 to 40, 65 to
72, 97 to 104
A
-119 to -112, -87 to -80, -55 to -48, -23 to -16, 9 to 16, 41 to 48, 73 to
80, 105 to 112
B
-111 to -104, -79 to -72, -47 to -40, -15 to -8, 17 to 24, 49 to 56, 81 to
88, 113 to 120
C
-103 to -96, -71 to -64, -39 to -32, -7 to 0, 25 to 32, 57 to 64, 89 to 96,
121 to 127
D
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–257
B
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
C
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
D
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE
ASSEMBLY
A
12
INSPECT HYBRID VEHICLE MOTOR ASSEMBLY
Hybrid Vehicle Motor:
I14
U
V
W
A092045E03
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the service
plug grip removed could cause malfunction. Therefore,
never turn the power switch ON (READY) in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
(d) Disconnect the three-phase alternating current cable for
the hybrid vehicle motor from the inverter.
(e) Using a milliohm meter, measure the resistance between
the three-phase alternating current cable terminals of the
hybrid vehicle motor.
NOTICE:
If the motor temperature is too high, the resistance varies
considerably, which hinders determining malfunction.
Therefore, measure the resistance at a minimum 8 hours
after the vehicle has been stopped.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition*
U (I14-1) - V (I14-2)
Below 135 mΩ at 20°C
V (I14-2) - W (I14-3)
Below 135 mΩ at 20°C
W (I14-3) - U (I14-1)
Below 135 mΩ at 20°C
*: Apply the formula given below to correct the resistance.
R20 = Rt / {1 + 0.00393 x (T - 20)}
R20: Resistance converted to 20°C (mΩ)
Rt: Resistance between measured lines (mΩ)
T: Ambient air temperature during measurement (°C)
(f) Calculate the difference between the maximum and
minimum resistance between terminals U - V, V - W, and
W - U.
Standard resistance:
Below 2 mΩ
(g) Using a megohmmeter, measure the insulation
resistance between the three-phase alternating current
cable terminals of the hybrid vehicle motor and the body
ground.
HV
HV–258
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
U (I14-1) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
V (I14-2) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
W (I14-3) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
(h) Reconnect the three-phase alternating current cable for
the hybrid vehicle motor.
NG
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE MOTOR
ASSEMBLY
OK
13
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (INVERTER STOP)
HV
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Check that the service plug grip and inverter cover have
been removed.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when turning
the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug grip and
inverter cover removed.
(d) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(e) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / ACTIVE TEST.
(f) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the
inverter connector while effecting INVERTER STOP.
Standard voltage
I10
MUU MVU MWU
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
MUU (I10-9) - GINV (I10-16)
12 to 16 V
MVU (I10-10) - GINV (I10-16)
12 to 16 V
MWU (I10-11) - GINV (I10-16)
12 to 16 V
(g) Turn the power switch OFF.
OK
I10
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
GINV
Inverter Connector
A093730E08
NG
14
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (INVERTER STOP)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
I10
MUU MVU MWU
I10
GINV
Inverter Connector
A093731E06
HV–259
(a) Check that the service plug grip and inverter cover have
been removed.
(b) Disconnect the I10 inverter connector.
(c) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
Inverter Connector DTCs for the interlock switch system are
output when turning the power switch ON (IG) with both
service plug grip and inverter cover removed.
(e) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(f) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / ACTIVE TEST.
(g) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the
inverter connector while effecting INVERTER STOP.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
MUU (I10-9) - GINV (I10-16)
14 to 16 V
MVU (I10-10) - GINV (I10-16)
14 to 16 V
MWU (I10-11) - GINV (I10-16)
14 to 16 V
(h)
(i)
(j)
(k)
Turn the power switch OFF.
Reconnect the inverter connector.
Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
OK
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
HV
HV–260
DTC
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
P0A78286
Drive Motor "A" Inverter Performance
DESCRIPTION
See the description of the inverter (see page HV-220).
If the motor inverter has a circuit malfunction, internal short, or overheats, the inverter transmits that
information to the MFIV terminal of the HV control ECU via the motor inverter fail signal line.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A78
286
Motor inverter fail (MFIV) signal
detection (circuit malfunction)
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
If the motor inverter detects a circuit malfunction, it transmits a motor inverter fail signal to the HV control
ECU. Upon receiving this signal, the HV control ECU illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A78 (INF 286): Motor inverter / MFIV detection circuit malfunction
Required sensor / components
Motor inverter
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
HV
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
No other condition
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Motor inverter
Circuit malfunction
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Motor inverter
DTC P0A78 (INF 286) is not detected
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0A78 (INF 282) (see page HV-244).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
1
HV–261
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV ECU)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTC listed in the table below is output
DTC No.
INF Code
Detection Item
See Page
P0A78
283 or 285
Drive Motor "A" Inverter
performance
HV-247
YES
GO TO THE PAGE NUMBER SHOWN IN THE
TABLE ABOVE
NO
2
CHECK CONNECTION CONDITION OF INVERTER CONNECTOR (LOOSENESS AND
POOR CONTACT)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the service
plug grip removed could cause malfunction. Therefore,
never turn the power switch ON (READY) in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
(d) Check the connection condition of the I9 and I10 inverter
connectors.
OK:
Connectors have been connected securely and
there is no poor connection.
(e) Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
(f) Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
I10
I9
Inverter Connector
NG
CONNECT SECURELY
A092044E05
OK
3
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV ECU)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HV
HV–262
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when turning
the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug grip and
inverter cover removed.
(c) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTCs P0A78 (INF 282, 286) and P0A7A (INF 324)
(inverter circuit malfunction) are output
NO
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
YES
4
INSPECT INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY (IGCT VOLTAGE)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the service
plug grip removed could cause malfunction. Therefore,
never turn the power switch ON (READY) in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when turning
the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug grip and
inverter cover removed.
(e) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the
inverter connector.
Standard voltage
HV
I9
Inverter Connector
GND1(-)
IGCT (+)
A093729E03
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
IGCT (I9-1) - GND1 (I9-2)
8 V or more
(f) Turn the power switch OFF.
(g) Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
(h) Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A78287
Drive Motor "A" Inverter Performance
DTC
P0A78505
Drive Motor "A" Inverter Performance
DTC
P0A78506
Drive Motor "A" Inverter Performance
HV–263
DESCRIPTION
See the description of the inverter (see page HV-220).
If the motor inverter has a circuit malfunction, internal short, or overheats, the inverter transmits that
information to the MFIV terminal of the HV control ECU via the motor inverter fail signal line.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A78
287
Motor inverter fail (MFIV) signal
detection (over current by inverter
assembly malfunction)
•
•
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
HV transaxle assembly
Hybrid vehicle motor
HV control ECU
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0A78
505
Motor inverter fail (MFIV) signal
detection (over current by HV
control ECU malfunction)
•
•
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
HV transaxle assembly
Hybrid vehicle motor
HV control ECU
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0A78
506
Motor inverter fail (MFIV) signal
detection (over current by HV
transaxle assembly malfunction)
•
•
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
HV transaxle assembly
Hybrid vehicle motor
HV control ECU
Inverter with converter
assembly
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
If over-amperage flows through the motor inverter due to an internal short, the motor inverter transmits an
inverter fail signal to the HV control ECU. Upon receiving this signal, the HV control ECU illuminates the
MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A78 (INF 287 / 505 / 506): Motor inverter / MFIV detection over
current
Required sensor / components
Motor inverter
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
No other condition
-
HV
HV–264
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Motor inverter
Over current (internal short)
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Motor inverter
DTC P0A78 (INF 287 / 505 / 506) is not detected
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0A78 (INF 279) (see page HV-235).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV ECU)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTCs listed in the table below are output
HV
DTC No.
Relevant Diagnosis
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
P0A2B, P0A2C or P0A2D
Drive Motor "A" Temperature Sensor Circuit System
P0A37, P0A38 or P0A39
Generator Temperature Sensor Circuit System
P0A3F, P0A40 or P0A4
Drive Motor "A" Position Sensor Circuit System
P0A4B, P0A4C or P0A4D
Generator Position Sensor Circuit System
P0A60 or P0A63
Drive Motor "A" Current Sensor Circuit System
P0A72 or P0A75
Generator Current Sensor Circuit System
P0A78
Drive Motor "A" Inverter Performance
P0A7A
Generator Inverter Performance
P0A90
Drive Motor "A" Performance
P0A92
Hybrid Generator Performance
P0A93
Inverter Cooling System Malfunction
P0A94
DC / DC Converter Malfunction
P0AA1, P0AA4, P0AE0, P0AE6, P0AE7, P0ADB or P0ADF
System Main Relay Circuit System
P0AA6, P3004
High Voltage System
P0AEE
Motor Inverter Temperature Sensor Malfunction
P3000
HV Battery System Malfunction
P3110
Integration Relay Malfunction
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–265
DTC No.
Relevant Diagnosis
P3221
Generator Inverter Temperature Sensor Circuit System
P3226
DC / DC Boost Converter Temperature Sensor Circuit System
YES
GO TO DTC CHART. FIND PAGE NUMBER
TO PROCEED TO DIAGNOSTIC
TROUBLESHOOTING FLOWCHART
NO
2
CHECK CONNECTION CONDITION OF HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU CONNECTOR
(LOOSENESS AND POOR CONTACT)
(a) Check the connection condition of all the connectors at
the HV control ECU.
OK:
Connectors have been connected securely and
there is no poor connection.
NG
CONNECT SECURELY
HV Control ECU Connector
A093719E09
OK
3
CHECK CONNECTION CONDITION OF INVERTER CONNECTOR (LOOSENESS AND
POOR CONTACT)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the service
plug grip removed could cause malfunction. Therefore,
never turn the power switch ON (READY) in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
(d) Check the connection condition of the I9 and I10 inverter
connectors.
OK:
Connectors have been connected securely and
there is no poor connection.
I10
I9
NG
Inverter Connector
A092044E05
OK
CONNECT SECURELY
HV
HV–266
4
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK HYBRID VEHICLE MOTOR ASSEMBLY
A090458E01
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Check that the service plug grip and inverter cover have
been removed.
(b) Check if the three-phase alternating current cable
installation bolts on the hybrid vehicle motor are
tightened to the specified torque.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
(c) Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
(d) Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
TIGHTEN THEM TO SPECIFIED TORQUE
OK
5
CONFIRM INFORMATION (EXCLUSIVE INFO 4)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when turning
the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug grip and
inverter cover removed.
(c) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Select DTC P0A78 to display its freeze frame data.
(f) Select the item that has INF code 287, 505, or 506 from
among INFORMATION 1 to 5, and press ENTER.
(g) Read EXCLUSIVE INFO 4.
HV
Result:
Displayed in Exclusive Information 4
Proceed to
-127 to -120, -95 to -88, -63 to -56, -31 to -24, 1 to 8, 33 to 40, 65 to
72, 97 to 104
A
-119 to -112, -87 to -80, -55 to -48, -23 to -16, 9 to 16, 41 to 48, 73 to
80, 105 to 112
B
-111 to -104, -79 to -72, -47 to -40, -15 to -8, 17 to 24, 49 to 56, 81 to
88, 113 to 120
C
-103 to -96, -71 to -64, -39 to -32, -7 to 0, 25 to 32, 57 to 64, 89 to 96,
121 to 127
D
B
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
C
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
D
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE
ASSEMBLY
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–267
A
6
INSPECT HYBRID VEHICLE MOTOR ASSEMBLY
Hybrid Vehicle Motor:
I14
U
V
W
A092045E03
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the service
plug grip removed could cause malfunction. Therefore,
never turn the power switch ON (READY) in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
(d) Disconnect the three-phase alternating current cable for
the hybrid vehicle motor from the inverter.
(e) Using a milliohm meter, measure the resistance between
the three-phase alternating current cable terminals of the
hybrid vehicle motor.
NOTICE:
If the motor temperature is too high, the resistance
varies considerably, which hinders determining
malfunction. Therefore, measure the resistance at a
minimum 8 hours after the vehicle has been
stopped.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition*
U (I14-1) - V (I14-2)
Below 135 mΩ at 20°C
V (I14-2) - W (I14-3)
Below 135 mΩ at 20°C
W (I14-3) - U (I14-1)
Below 135 mΩ at 20°C
*: Apply the formula given below to correct the
resistance.
R20 = Rt / {(1 + 0.00393 x (T - 20)}
Rt: Resistance between measured lines (mΩ)
R20: Resistance converted to 20°C (mΩ)
T: Ambient air temperature during measurement (°C)
(f) Calculate the difference between the maximum and
minimum resistance between terminals U - V, V - W, and
W - U.
Standard resistance:
Below 2 mΩ
(g) Using a megohmmeter, measure the insulation
resistance between the three-phase alternating current
cable terminals of the hybrid vehicle motor and the body
ground.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
U (I14-1) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
V (I14-2) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
W (I14-3) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
HV
HV–268
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
(h) Reconnect the three-phase alternating current cable for
the hybrid vehicle motor.
NG
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE MOTOR
ASSEMBLY
OK
7
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (INVERTER STOP)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Check that the service plug grip and inverter cover have
been removed.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(d) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(e) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / ACTIVE TEST.
(f) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the
inverter connector while effecting INVERTER STOP.
Standard voltage
I10
HV
MUU MVU MWU
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
MUU (I10-9) - GINV (I10-16)
12 to 16 V
MVU (I10-10) - GINV (I10-16)
12 to 16 V
MWU (I10-11) - GINV (I10-16)
12 to 16 V
(g) Turn the power switch OFF.
OK
I10
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
GINV
Inverter Connector
A093730E08
NG
8
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (INVERTER STOP)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Check that the service plug grip and inverter cover have
been removed.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
I10
MUU MVU MWU
I10
GINV
Inverter Connector
(b) Disconnect the I10 inverter connector.
(c) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when turning
the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug grip and
inverter cover removed.
(e) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(f) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / ACTIVE TEST.
(g) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the
inverter connector while effecting INVERTER STOP.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
A093731E06
HV–269
Specified Condition
MUU (I10-9) - GINV (I10-16)
14 to 16 V
MVU (I10-10) - GINV (I10-16)
14 to 16 V
MWU (I10-11) - GINV (I10-16)
14 to 16 V
(h)
(i)
(j)
(k)
Turn the power switch OFF.
Reconnect the inverter connector.
Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
OK
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
HV
HV–270
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A78304
Drive Motor "A" Inverter Performance
DTC
P0A78305
Drive Motor "A" Inverter Performance
DTC
P0A78507
Drive Motor "A" Inverter Performance
DESCRIPTION
See the description of the inverter (see page HV-220).
Upon receiving a motor gate shutdown signal from the HV control ECU, the inverter forcefully stops the
operation of the MG2 by turning OFF the power transistors that are actuating the MG2.
The HV control ECU monitors the motor gate shutdown signal line and detects a malfunction.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A78
304
Open or +B short in motor gate
shutdown (MSDN) signal circuit
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0A78
305
GND short in motor gate
shutdown (MSDN) signal circuit
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0A78
507
Open in motor gate shutdown
(MSDN) signal circuit
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
HV
The HV control ECU monitors the motor gate shutdown (MSDN) signal line. If the HV control ECU detects
an open or short malfunction of the MSDN signal circuit, the HV control ECU illuminates the MIL and sets
a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A78 (INF 304 / 305 / 507):
Motor inverter / Motor gate shutdown signal malfunction
Required sensor / components
Motor inverter
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
1 driving cycle
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Motor gate shutdown signal circuit
Open or short
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–271
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Motor inverter
DTC P0A78 (INF 304 / 305 / 507) is not detected
WIRING DIAGRAM
HV Control ECU
Inverter
(Shielded)
25
MSDN I10
G
A
8
H15 MSDN
J5
J/C
IK
A092105E04
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - INVERTER)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
HV
HV–272
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
(c) Disconnect the H15 HV control ECU connector.
(d) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
(e) Disconnect the I10 inverter connector.
H15
MSDN
HV Control ECU Connector
Wire Harness Side
A065744E28
(f)
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(g) Measure the voltage between the terminal of the HV
control ECU connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
I10
I10
Inverter Connector
MSDN
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
MSDN (H15-8) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(h) Turn the power switch OFF.
(i) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
A092041E39
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
MSDN (H15-8) - MSDN (I10-25)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
HV
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
MSDN (H15-8) or MSDN (I10-25) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(j)
(k)
(l)
(m)
Reconnect the inverter connector.
Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A78306
HV–273
Drive Motor "A" Inverter Performance
DESCRIPTION
See the description of the inverter (see page HV-220).
The HV control ECU controls MG2 torque in accordance with the driving condition.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A78
306
Failure in monitoring MG2 torque
performance
•
•
Hybrid vehicle motor
Inverter with converter
assembly
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
If the difference between the requested MG2 torque and the actual MG2 torque exceeds a predetermined
value, the HV control ECU determines that there is malfunction in the execution or monitoring of the MG2
torque. Then, the HV control ECU illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A78 (INF 306):
Discrepancy between motor monitored torque and commanded torque
Required sensor / components
Motor inverter
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
No other condition
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Difference between demanded and actual MG2 torque
Exceeds the standard level
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Motor inverter
DTC P0A78 (INF 306) is not detected
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
HV
HV–274
1
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV ECU)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTC P0A78 (INF 306) and other DTCs are output
HINT:
If any other codes besides P0A78 (INF 306) are output,
perform troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
YES
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
NO
2
INSPECT HYBRID VEHICLE MOTOR ASSEMBLY
HV
Hybrid Vehicle Motor:
I14
U
V
W
A092045E03
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
(d) Disconnect the three-phase alternating current cable for
the hybrid vehicle motor from the inverter.
(e) Using a milliohm meter, measure the resistance between
the three-phase alternating current cable terminals of the
hybrid vehicle motor.
NOTICE:
If the motor temperature is too high, the resistance
varies considerably, which hinders determining
malfunction. Therefore, measure the resistance at a
minimum 8 hours after the vehicle has been
stopped.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition*
U (I14-1) - V (I14-2)
Below 135 mΩ at 20°C
V (I14-2) - W (I14-3)
Below 135 mΩ at 20°C
W (I14-3) - U (I14-1)
Below 135 mΩ at 20°C
*: Apply the formula given below to correct the
resistance.
R20 = Rt / {1 + 0.00393 x (T - 20)}
R20: Resistance converted to 20°C (mΩ)
Rt: Resistance between measured lines (mΩ)
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–275
T: Ambient air temperature during measurement (°C)
Calculate the difference between the maximum and
minimum resistance between terminals U - V, V - W, and
W - U.
Standard resistance:
Below 2 mΩ
(g) Using a megohmmeter, measure the insulation
resistance between the three-phase alternating current
cable terminals of the hybrid vehicle motor and the body
ground.
Standard resistance
(f)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
U (I14-1) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
V (I14-2) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
W (I14-3) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
(h) Reconnect the three-phase alternating current cable for
the hybrid vehicle motor.
(i) Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
(j) Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE MOTOR
ASSEMBLY
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
HV
HV–276
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A78308
Drive Motor "A" Inverter Performance
DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU receives a collision signal from the center airbag sensor and the No. 1 circuit breaker
sensor to determine that the vehicle has been damaged. Then, it cuts off the high-voltage system to
ensure safety. If the HV control ECU receives the collision signal only from the center airbag sensor, it
turns OFF the system main relay and the power switch. If the HV control ECU receives the collision signal
only from the No. 1circuit breaker sensor, it turns only the system main relay OFF.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A78
308
Collision signal input from center
airbag sensor or No. 1 circuit
breaker sensor
•
•
Supplemental restraint
system
No. 1 circuit breaker sensor
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK VEHICLE FOR ANY DAMAGE
(a) Check the vehicle for any damage.
Result:
The vehicle is damaged.
YES
REPAIR VEHICLE
NO
2
HV
GO TO SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
(a) Troubleshoot the airbag system.
Result:
There is malfunction in the airbag system.
NO
REPLACE NO. 1 CIRCUIT BREAKER
SENSOR
YES
REPAIR MALFUNCTIONING PARTS AND COMPONENTS
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A78508
HV–277
Drive Motor "A" Inverter Performance
DESCRIPTION
See the description of the inverter (see page HV-220).
Upon receiving a motor gate shutdown signal from the HV control ECU, the inverter forcefully stops the
operation of the MG2 by turning OFF the power transistors that are actuating the MG2.
The HV control ECU monitors the motor gate shutdown signal and detects a malfunction.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A78
508
Motor gate shutdown (MSDN)
signal malfunction
•
•
Wire harness or connector
HV control ECU
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU monitors the motor gate shutdown (MSDN) signal. If the HV control ECU detects a
fault in the MSDN signal, it illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A78 (INF 508):
Motor inverter shutdown signal line malfunction
Required sensor / components
Motor inverter
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Actual status of shutdown command signal and its monitoring result
Inconsistent
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Motor inverter
DTC P0A78 (INF 508) is not detected
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0A78 (INF 304) (see page HV-269).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HV
HV–278
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV ECU)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTC P0A78 (INF 508) and other DTCs are output
HINT:
If any other codes besides P0A78 (INF 508) are output,
perform troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
YES
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
NO
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - INVERTER)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Disconnect the H15 HV control ECU connector.
(d) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
HV
H15
MSDN
HV Control ECU Connector
A065744E28
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Wire Harness Side
(e) Disconnect the I10 inverter connector.
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(f) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(g) Measure the voltage between the terminal of the H15 HV
control ECU connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
I10
I10
Inverter Connector
HV–279
MSDN
A092041E39
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
MSDN (H15-8) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(h) Turn the power switch OFF.
(i) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
MSDN (H15-8) - MSDN (I10-25)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
MSDN (H15-8) or MSDN (I10-25) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(j)
(k)
(l)
(m)
Reconnect the inverter connector.
Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
OK
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
HV
HV–280
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A78510
Drive Motor "A" Inverter Performance
DESCRIPTION
See the description of the inverter (see page HV-220).
Upon receiving a motor gate shutdown signal from the HV control ECU, the inverter forcefully stops the
operation of the MG2 by turning OFF the power transistors that are actuating the MG2.
The HV control ECU monitors the motor gate shutdown signal and detects a malfunction.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A78
510
Motor inverter gate malfunction
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0A78 (INF 304) (see page HV-269).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
HV
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - INVERTER)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Disconnect the H15 HV control ECU connector.
(d) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
H15
MSDN
HV Control ECU Connector
A065744E28
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Wire Harness Side
(e) Disconnect the I10 inverter connector.
(f) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(g) Measure the voltage between the terminal of the H15 HV
control ECU connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
I10
I10
Inverter Connector
HV–281
MSDN
A092041E39
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
MSDN (H15-8) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(h) Turn the power switch OFF.
(i) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
MSDN (H15-8) - MSDN (I10-25)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
MSDN (H15-8) or MSDN (I10-25) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(j)
(k)
(l)
(m)
Reconnect the inverter connector.
Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
HV
HV–282
DTC
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
P0A78523
Drive Motor "A" Inverter Performance
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0A78 (INF 266) (see page HV-220).
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A78
523
Inverter voltage (VH) sensor
offset malfunction
•
•
System main relay
Inverter with converter
assembly
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU monitors the inverter voltage (VH) sensor signal. If the HV control ECU detects a
fault in the sensor signal, the HV control ECU interprets this as a VH sensor failure. The HV control ECU
then illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A78 (INF 523): Voltage (VH) malfunction
Required sensor / components
Motor inverter, battery ECU
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
HV
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Motor inverter
DTC P0A78 (INF 523) is not detected
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
1
HV–283
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV ECU)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTC P0A78 (INF 523) and other DTCs are output
HINT:
If any other codes besides P0A78 (INF 523) are output,
perform troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
YES
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
NO
2
CHECK SYSTEM MAIN RELAYS FOR STICKING
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Disconnect all the high-voltage terminals of the system
main relays.
(d) Measure the resistance at the switch side of the system
main relays.
Standard resistance:
10 kΩ or higher
(e) Connect the high-voltage terminals of the system main
relays.
(f) Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
A087664E02
NG
REPLACE STUCK SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
HV
HV–284
DTC
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
P0A78586
Drive Motor "A" Inverter Performance
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0A78 (INF 266) (see page HV-220).
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A78
586
Inverter voltage (VH) sensor
performance problem
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU monitors the inverter voltage (VH) sensor signal. If the HV control ECU detects a
fault in the sensor signal, the HV control ECU interprets this as a VH sensor failure. The HV control ECU
then illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A78 (INF 586): Voltage (VH) sensor deviation
Required sensor / components
Motor inverter, battery ECU
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
HV
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Motor inverter
DTC P0A78 (INF 586) is not detected
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0A78 (INF 266) (see page HV-223).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
1
HV–285
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV ECU)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTC P0A78 (INF 586) and other DTCs are output
HINT:
If any other codes besides P0A78 (INF 586) are output,
perform troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
YES
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
NO
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - INVERTER)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Disconnect the H15 HV control ECU connector.
(d) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
H15
VH
GINV
HV Control ECU Connector
A065744E22
HV
HV–286
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Wire Harness Side
I10
VH GINV
I10
Inverter Connector
A092041E40
(e) Disconnect the I10 inverter connector.
(f) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(g) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the HV
control ECU connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VH (H15-26) - Body ground
Below 1 V
GINV (H15-23) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(h) Turn the power switch OFF.
(i) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VH (H15-26) - VH (I10-12)
Below 1 Ω
GINV (H15-23) - GINV (I10-16)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VH (H15-26) or VH (I10-12) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
GINV (H15-23) or GINV (I10-16) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(j)
(k)
(l)
(m)
HV
Reconnect the inverter connector.
Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A7A309
HV–287
Generator Inverter Performance
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0A78 (INF 272) (see page HV-228).
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A7A
309
Abnormality in generator PWM
circuit
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU monitors the generator PWM circuit. If there is an error in the power transistor
actuation signals which are transmitted to the inverter, the HV control ECU interprets this as a malfunction
of the generator PWM circuit.
The HV control ECU illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A7A (INF 309):
Generator PWM malfunction
Required sensor / components
Generator inverter
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
1 driving cycle
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Power transistor actuation signal
Abnormal
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Generator inverter
DTC P0A7A (INF 309) is not detected
HV
HV–288
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
HV Control ECU
(Shielded)
Inverter
6
GWU I10
13
H15 GWU
Y
5
GVU I10
G
14
H15 GVU
4
GUU I10
B
15
H15 GUU
A
J5
J/C
IK
A092101E03
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HV
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV ECU)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTC P0A1D is output
YES
NO
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
2
HV–289
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - INVERTER)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
(d) Disconnect the H15 HV control ECU connector.
H15
GUU
GVU
GWU
HV Control ECU Connector
A065744E30
Wire Harness Side
GUU
GVU
(e) Disconnect the I10 inverter connector.
(f) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
I10
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
GUU (H15-15) - GUU (I10-4)
Below 1 Ω
GVU (H15-14) - GVU (I10-5)
Below 1 Ω
GWU (H15-13) - GWU (I10-6)
Below 1 Ω
GWU
Standard resistance (Check for short)
I10
Inverter Connector
A092041E41
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
GUU (H15-15) or GUU (I10-4) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
GVU (H15-14) or GVU (I10-5) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
GWU (H15-13) or GWU (I10-6) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(g)
(h)
(i)
(j)
Reconnect the inverter connector.
Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
HV
HV–290
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A7A321
Generator Inverter Performance
DTC
P0A7A323
Generator Inverter Performance
DESCRIPTION
See the description of the inverter (see page HV-220).
If the generator inverter has a circuit malfunction, internal short, or overheats, the inverter transmits that
information to the GFIV terminal of the HV control ECU via the generator inverter fail signal line.
The HV control ECU monitors the generator inverter fail signal line and detects a malfunction.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A7A
321
+B short in generator inverter fail
(GFIV) signal circuit
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0A7A
323
Open or GND short in generator
inverter fail (GFIV) signal circuit
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU monitors the generator inverter fail (GFIV) signal line. If the HV control ECU detects
an open or short malfunction of the GFIV signal circuit, the HV control ECU illuminates the MIL and sets a
DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
HV
Related DTCs
P0A7A (INF 321 / 323):
Generator inverter Finv detection
Required sensor / components
Generator Inverter
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
1 driving cycle
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Generator inverter fail signal circuit
Open or short
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Generator inverter
DTC P0A7A (INF 321 / 323) is not detected
HV–291
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
HV Control ECU
Inverter
GFIV
22
I10
35
H15 GFIV
GR
(Shielded)
16
GI NV I10
23
H15 GINV
Y
A
J5
J/C
IK
A092102E08
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - INVERTER)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Disconnect the H15 HV control ECU connector.
(d) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
H15
GFIV
GINV
HV Control ECU Connector
A065744E31
HV
HV–292
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Wire Harness Side
(e) Disconnect the I10 inverter connector.
(f) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(g) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the HV
control ECU connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
I10
GINV
I10
GFIV
Inverter Connector
A092041E42
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
GFIV (H15-35) - Body ground
Below 1 V
GINV (H15-23) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(h) Turn the power switch OFF.
(i) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
GFIV (H15-35) - GFIV (I10-22)
Below 1 Ω
GINV (H15-23) - GINV (I10-16)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
GFIV (H15-35) or GFIV (I10-22) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
GINV (H15-23) or GINV (I10-16) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(j)
(k)
(l)
(m)
HV
Reconnect the inverter connector.
Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A7A322
HV–293
Generator Inverter Performance
DESCRIPTION
See the description of the inverter (see page HV-220).
If the generator inverter has a circuit malfunction, internal short, or overheats, the inverter transmits that
information to the GFIV terminal of HV control ECU via the generator inverter fail signal line.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A7A
322
Generator inverter fail (GFIV)
signal detection (inverter
overheating)
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter cooling system
Water pump with motor
assembly
Cooling fan motor
No. 2 cooling fan motor
HV transaxle assembly
Hybrid vehicle generator
HV control ECU
Inverter with converter
assembly
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
If the generator inverter overheats, it transmits an inverter fail signal to the HV control ECU. Upon
receiving this signal, the HV control ECU illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A7A (INF 322): Generator inverter / GFIV detection over heat
Required sensor / components
Generator inverter
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
No other condition
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Generator inverter
Overheated
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Generator inverter
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0A78 (INF 279) (see page HV-235).
DTC P0A7A (INF 322) is not detected
HV
HV–294
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV ECU)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTCs listed in the table below are output
DTC No.
HV
Relevant Diagnosis
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
P0A2B, P0A2C or P0A2D
Drive Motor "A" Temperature Sensor Circuit System
P0A37, P0A38 or P0A39
Generator Temperature Sensor Circuit System
P0A3F, P0A40 or P0A4
Drive Motor "A" Position Sensor Circuit System
P0A4B, P0A4C or P0A4D
Generator Position Sensor Circuit System
P0A60 or P0A63
Drive Motor "A" Current Sensor Circuit System
P0A72 or P0A75
Generator Current Sensor Circuit System
P0A78
Drive Motor "A" Inverter Performance
P0A7A
Generator Inverter Performance
P0A90
Drive Motor "A" Performance
P0A92
Hybrid Generator Performance
P0A93
Inverter Cooling System Malfunction
P0A94
DC / DC Converter Malfunction
P0AA1, P0AA4, P0AE0, P0AE6, P0AE7, P0ADB or P0ADF
System Main Relay Circuit System
P0AA6, P3004
High Voltage System
P0AEE
Motor Inverter Temperature Sensor Malfunction
P3000
HV Battery System Malfunction
P3110
Integration Relay Malfunction
P3221
Generator Inverter Temperature Sensor Circuit System
P3226
DC / DC Boost Converter Temperature Sensor Circuit System
YES
NO
GO TO DTC CHART. FIND PAGE NUMBER
TO PROCEED TO DIAGNOSTIC
TROUBLESHOOTING FLOWCHART
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
2
HV–295
CHECK QUANTITY OF HV COOLANT
(a) Check that there is a sufficient amount of coolant for the
inverter.
OK:
There is a sufficient amount of coolant for the
inverter
NG
ADD HV COOLANT
OK
3
CHECK COOLANT HOSE
(a) Check that the hoses of the cooling system are not bent
or clogged (refer to the cooling system [see page HV346]).
OK:
The hoses of the cooling system are not bent or
clogged
NG
CORRECT TO NORMAL CONDITION
OK
4
CHECK CONNECTION CONDITION OF WATER PUMP CONNECTOR (LOOSENESS AND
POOR CONTACT)
(a) Check the connection condition of the water pump
connector.
OK:
Connector has been connected securely and there
is no poor connection.
NG
CONNECT SECURELY
A090415E03
OK
5
CHECK WATER PUMP WITH MOTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Check the operation of the water pump.
OK:
Coolant is sloshing in the reservoir tank
NG
REPLACE WATER PUMP WITH MOTOR
ASSEMBLY
HV
HV–296
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
OK
6
CHECK CONNECTION CONDITION OF COOLING FAN MOTOR CONNECTOR
(LOOSENESS AND POOR CONTACT)
(a) Check the connection condition of the cooling fan motor
connectors.
OK:
Connectors have been connected securely and
there is no poor connection.
NG
CONNECT SECURELY
A090546E01
OK
7
INSPECT COOLING FAN MOTOR
(a) Inspect the cooling fan motor (see page CO-5).
NG
REPLACE COOLING FAN MOTOR AND ADD
ENGINE COOLANT
OK
8
INSPECT NO. 2 COOLING FAN MOTOR
HV
(a) Inspect the No. 2 cooling fan motor (see page CO-5).
NG
REPLACE NO. 2 COOLING FAN MOTOR AND
ADD ENGINE COOLANT
OK
9
CHECK CONNECTION CONDITION OF HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU CONNECTOR
(LOOSENESS AND POOR CONTACT)
(a) Check the connection condition of all the connectors at
the HV control ECU.
OK:
Connectors have been connected securely and
there is no poor connection.
NG
HV Control ECU Connector
A093719E09
OK
CONNECT SECURELY
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
10
HV–297
CHECK CONNECTION CONDITION OF INVERTER CONNECTOR (LOOSENESS AND
POOR CONTACT)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
(d) Check the connection condition of the I9 and I10 inverter
connectors.
OK:
Connectors have been connected securely and
there is no poor connection.
(e) Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
(f) Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
I10
I9
Inverter Connector
NG
CONNECT SECURELY
A092044E05
OK
11
CONFIRM INFORMATION (EXCLUSIVE INFO 4)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(c) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Select DTC P0A7A to display its freeze frame data.
(f) Select the item that has INF code 322 from among
INFORMATION 1 to 5, and press ENTER.
(g) Read EXCLUSIVE INFO 4.
Result:
Displayed in Exclusive Information 4
Proceed to
-127 to -120, -95 to -88, -63 to -56, -31 to -24, 1 to 8, 33 to 40, 65 to
72, 97 to 104
A
-119 to -112, -87 to -80, -55 to -48, -23 to -16, 9 to 16, 41 to 48, 73 to
80, 105 to 112
B
-111 to -104, -79 to -72, -47 to -40, -15 to -8, 17 to 24, 49 to 56, 81 to
88, 113 to 120
C
-103 to -96, -71 to -64, -39 to -32, -7 to 0, 25 to 32, 57 to 64, 89 to 96,
121 to 127
D
HV
HV–298
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
B
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
C
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
D
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE
ASSEMBLY
A
12
INSPECT HYBRID VEHICLE GENERATOR ASSEMBLY
Hybrid Vehicle Generator:
I15
HV
V
W
U
A092046E03
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
(d) Disconnect the three-phase alternating current cable for
the hybrid vehicle generator from the inverter.
(e) Using a milliohm meter, measure the resistance between
the three-phase alternating current cable terminals of the
hybrid vehicle generator.
NOTICE:
If the generator temperature is too high, the
resistance varies considerably, which hinders
determining malfunction. Therefore, measure the
resistance at a minimum 8 hours after the vehicle
has been stopped.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition*
U (I15-1) - V (I15-2)
Below 109 mΩ at 20°C
V (I15-2) - W (I15-3)
Below 109 mΩ at 20°C
W (I15-3) - U (I15-1)
Below 109 mΩ at 20°C
(f)
*: Apply the formula given below to correct the
resistance.
R20 = Rt / {1 + 0.00393 x (T - 20)}
R20: Resistance converted to 20°C (mΩ)
Rt: Resistance between measured lines (mΩ)
T: Ambient air temperature during measurement (°C)
Calculate the difference between the maximum and
minimum resistance between terminals U - V, V - W, and
W - U.
Standard resistance:
Below 2 mΩ
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–299
(g) Using a megohmmeter, measure the insulation
resistance between the three-phase alternating current
cable terminals of the hybrid vehicle generator and the
body ground.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
U (I15-1) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
V (I15-2) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
W (I15-3) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
(h) Reconnect the three-phase alternating current cable for
the hybrid vehicle generator.
NG
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE GENERATOR
ASSEMBLY
OK
13
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (INVERTER STOP)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Check that the service plug grip and inverter cover have
been removed.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(d) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(e) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / ACTIVE TEST.
(f) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the
inverter connector while effecting INVERTER STOP.
Standard voltage
I10
Tester Connection
GUU
GVU GWU
GUU (I10-4) - GINV (I10-16)
12 to 16 V
GVU (I10-5) - GINV (I10-16)
12 to 16 V
GWU (I10-6) - GINV (I10-16)
12 to 16 V
(g) Turn the power switch OFF.
NG
I10
Inverter Connector
Specified Condition
GINV
A093730E09
Go to step 14
HV
HV–300
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
14
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (INVERTER STOP)
I10
GUU GVU
GWU
I10
GINV
Inverter Connector
A093731E07
HV
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Check that the service plug grip and inverter cover have
been removed.
(b) Disconnect the I10 inverter connector.
(c) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(e) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(f) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / ACTIVE TEST.
(g) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the
inverter connector while effecting INVERTER STOP.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
GUU (I10-4) - GINV (I10-16)
14 to 16 V
GVU (I10-5) - GINV (I10-16)
14 to 16 V
GWU (I10-6) - GINV (I10-16)
14 to 16 V
(h)
(i)
(j)
(k)
Turn the power switch OFF.
Reconnect the inverter connector.
Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
OK
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A7A324
HV–301
Generator Inverter Performance
DESCRIPTION
See the description of the inverter (see page HV-220).
If the generator inverter has a circuit malfunction, internal short, or overheats, the inverter transmits that
information to the GFIV terminal of HV control ECU via the generator inverter fail signal line.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A7A
324
Generator inverter fail (GFIV)
signal detection (circuit
malfunction)
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
If the generator inverter detects a circuit malfunction, it transmits an inverter fail signal to the HV control
ECU. Upon receiving this signal, the HV control ECU illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A7A (INF 324): Generator inverter / GFIV detection circuit
malfunction
Required sensor / components
Generator inverter
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
No other condition
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Generator inverter
Circuit malfunction
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Generator inverter
DTC P0A7A (INF 324) is not detected
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0A78 (INF 282) (see page HV-244).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HV
HV–302
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV ECU)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTC listed in the table below is output
DTC No.
INF Code
Detection Item
See Page
P0A7A
321 or 323
Generator Inverter Performance
HV-288
YES
GO TO THE PAGE NUMBER SHOWN IN THE
TABLE ABOVE
NO
2
CHECK CONNECTION CONDITION OF INVERTER CONNECTOR (LOOSENESS AND
POOR CONTACT)
HV
I10
I9
Inverter Connector
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
(d) Check the connection condition of the I9 and I10 inverter
connectors.
OK :
Connectors have been connected securely and
there is no poor connection.
(e) Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
(f) Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
CONNECT SECURELY
A092044E02
OK
3
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV ECU)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–303
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(c) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTCs P0A78 (INF 282, 286) and P0A7A (INF 324)
(inverter circuit malfunction) are output
NO
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
YES
4
INSPECT INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY (IGCT VOLTAGE)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(e) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the
inverter connector.
Standard voltage
I9
Inverter Connector
GND1(-)
IGCT (+)
A093729E02
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
IGCT (I9-1) - GND1 (I9-2)
8 V or more
(f) Turn the power switch OFF.
(g) Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
(h) Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
HV
HV–304
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A7A325
Generator Inverter Performance
DTC
P0A7A517
Generator Inverter Performance
DTC
P0A7A518
Generator Inverter Performance
DESCRIPTION
See the description of the inverter (see page HV-220).
If the generator inverter has a circuit malfunction, internal short, or overheats, the inverter transmits that
information to the GFIV terminal of HV control ECU via the generator inverter fail signal line.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A7A
325
Generator inverter fail (GFIV)
signal detection (over current by
inverter assembly malfunction)
•
•
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
HV transaxle assembly
Hybrid vehicle generator
HV control ECU
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0A7A
517
Generator inverter fail (GFIV)
signal detection (over current by
HV control ECU malfunction)
•
•
•
•
HV transaxle assembly
Hybrid vehicle generator
HV control ECU
Inverter with converter
assembly
Wire harness or connector
P0A7A
518
Generator inverter fail (GFIV)
signal detection (over current by
HV transaxle assembly
malfunction)
•
HV
•
•
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
HV transaxle assembly
Hybrid vehicle generator
HV control ECU
Inverter with converter
assembly
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
If over-amperage flows through the generator inverter due to an internal short, the generator inverter
transmits an inverter fail signal to the HV control ECU. Upon receiving this signal, the HV control ECU
illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A7A (INF 325 / 517 / 518):
Generator inverter / GFIV detection over current
Required sensor / components
Generator inverter
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
No other condition
-
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–305
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Generator inverter
Over current (internal short)
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Generator inverter
DTC P0A7A (INF 325 / 517 / 518) is not detected
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0A78 (INF 279) (see page HV-235).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV ECU)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTCs listed in the table below are output
DTC No.
Relevant Diagnosis
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
P0A2B, P0A2C or P0A2D
Drive Motor "A" Temperature Sensor Circuit System
P0A37, P0A38 or P0A39
Generator Temperature Sensor Circuit System
P0A3F, P0A40 or P0A4
Drive Motor "A" Position Sensor Circuit System
P0A4B, P0A4C or P0A4D
Generator Position Sensor Circuit System
P0A60 or P0A63
Drive Motor "A" Current Sensor Circuit System
P0A72 or P0A75
Generator Current Sensor Circuit System
P0A78
Drive Motor "A" Inverter Performance
P0A7A
Generator Inverter Performance
P0A90
Drive Motor "A" Performance
P0A92
Hybrid Generator Performance
P0A93
Inverter Cooling System Malfunction
P0A94
DC / DC Converter Malfunction
P0AA1, P0AA4, P0AE0, P0AE6, P0AE7, P0ADB or P0ADF
System Main Relay Circuit System
P0AA6, P3004
High Voltage System
P0AEE
Motor Inverter Temperature Sensor Malfunction
P3000
HV Battery System Malfunction
P3110
Integration Relay Malfunction
HV
HV–306
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC No.
Relevant Diagnosis
P3221
Generator Inverter Temperature Sensor Circuit System
P3226
DC / DC Boost Converter Temperature Sensor Circuit System
YES
GO TO DTC CHART. FIND PAGE NUMBER
TO PROCEED TO DIAGNOSTIC
TROUBLESHOOTING FLOWCHART
NO
2
CHECK CONNECTION CONDITION OF HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU CONNECTOR
(LOOSENESS AND POOR CONTACT)
(a) Check the connection condition of all the connectors at
the HV control ECU.
OK:
Connectors have been connected securely and
there is no poor connection.
NG
CONNECT SECURELY
HV Control ECU Connector
A093719E09
OK
3
CHECK CONNECTION CONDITION OF INVERTER CONNECTOR (LOOSENESS AND
POOR CONTACT)
HV
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
(d) Check the connection condition of the I9 and I10 inverter
connectors.
OK:
Connectors have been connected securely and
there is no poor connection.
I10
I9
NG
Inverter Connector
A092044E02
OK
CONNECT SECURELY
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
4
HV–307
CHECK HYBRID VEHICLE GENERATOR ASSEMBLY
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Check that the service plug grip and inverter cover have
been removed.
(b) Check if the three-phase alternating current cable
installation bolts on the hybrid vehicle generator are
tightened to the specified torque.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
(c) Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
(d) Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
TIGHTEN THEM TO SPECIFIED TORQUE
A090459E01
OK
5
CONFIRM INFORMATION (EXCLUSIVE INFO 4)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(c) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Select DTC P0A7A to display its freeze frame data.
(f) Select the item that has INF code 325, 517, or 518 from
among INFORMATION 1 to 5, and press ENTER.
(g) Read EXCLUSIVE INFO 4.
Result:
Displayed in Exclusive Information 4
Proceed to
-127 to -120, -95 to -88, -63 to -56, -31 to -24, 1 to 8, 33 to 40, 65 to
72, 97 to 104
A
-119 to -112, -87 to -80, -55 to -48, -23 to -16, 9 to 16, 41 to 48, 73 to
80, 105 to 112
B
-111 to -104, -79 to -72, -47 to -40, -15 to -8, 17 to 24, 49 to 56, 81 to
88, 113 to 120
C
-103 to -96, -71 to -64, -39 to -32, -7 to 0, 25 to 32, 57 to 64, 89 to 96,
121 to 127
D
B
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
C
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
HV
HV–308
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
D
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE
ASSEMBLY
A
6
INSPECT HYBRID VEHICLE GENERATOR ASSEMBLY
Hybrid Vehicle Generator:
I15
V
W
U
A092046E03
HV
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
(d) Disconnect the three-phase alternating current cable for
the hybrid vehicle generator from the inverter.
(e) Using a milliohm meter, measure the resistance between
the three-phase alternating current cable terminals of the
hybrid vehicle generator.
NOTICE:
If the generator temperature is too high, the
resistance varies considerably, which hinders
determining malfunction. Therefore, measure the
resistance at a minimum 8 hours after the vehicle
has been stopped.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition*
U (I15-1) - V (I15-2)
Below 109 mΩ at 20°C
V (I15-2) - W (I15-3)
Below 109 mΩ at 20°C
W (I15-3) - U (I15-1)
Below 109 mΩ at 20°C
*: Apply the formula given below to correct the
resistance.
R20 = Rt / {1 + 0.00393 x (T - 20)}
R20: Resistance converted to 20°C (mΩ)
Rt: Resistance between measured lines (mΩ)
T: Ambient air temperature during measurement (°C)
(f) Calculate the difference between the maximum and
minimum resistance between terminals U - V, V - W, and
W - U.
Standard resistance:
Below 2 mΩ
(g) Using a megohmmeter, measure the insulation
resistance between the three-phase alternating current
cable terminals of the hybrid vehicle generator and the
body ground.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
U (I15-1) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
V (I15-2) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
W (I15-3) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
HV–309
(h) Reconnect the three-phase alternating current cable for
the hybrid vehicle generator.
NG
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE GENERATOR
ASSEMBLY
OK
7
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (INVERTER STOP)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Check that the service plug grip and inverter cover have
been removed.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(d) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(e) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / ACTIVE TEST.
(f) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the
inverter connector while effecting INVERTER STOP.
Standard voltage
I10
GUU
GVU GWU
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
GUU (I10-4) - GINV (I10-16)
12 to 16 V
GVU (I10-5) - GINV (I10-16)
12 to 16 V
GWU (I10-6) - GINV (I10-16)
12 to 16 V
(g) Turn the power switch OFF.
NG
I10
Inverter Connector
GINV
A093730E09
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
Go to step 8
HV
HV–310
8
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (INVERTER STOP)
I10
GUU
GVU GWU
I10
Inverter Connector
GINV
A093730E09
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Check that the service plug grip and inverter cover have
been removed.
(b) Disconnect the I10 inverter connector.
(c) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(e) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(f) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / ACTIVE TEST.
(g) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the
inverter connector while effecting INVERTER STOP.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
GUU (I10-4) - GINV (I10-16)
14 to 16 V
GVU (I10-5) - GINV (I10-16)
14 to 16 V
GWU (I10-6) - GINV (I10-16)
14 to 16 V
(h)
(i)
(j)
(k)
HV
Turn the power switch OFF.
Reconnect the inverter connector.
Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
OK
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A7A342
Generator Inverter Performance
DTC
P0A7A343
Generator Inverter Performance
DTC
P0A7A519
Generator Inverter Performance
HV–311
DESCRIPTION
See the description of the inverter (see page HV-220).
Upon receiving a generator gate shutdown signal from the HV control ECU, the inverter forcefully stops
the operation of the MG1 by turning OFF the power transistors that are actuating the MG1.
The HV control ECU monitors the generator gate shutdown signal line and detects a malfunction.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A7A
342
Open or +B short in generator
gate shutdown (GSDN) signal
circuit
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0A7A
343
GND short in generator gate
shutdown (GSDN) signal circuit
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0A7A
519
Open in generator gate shutdown
(GSDN) signal circuit
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU monitors the generator gate shutdown (GSDN) signal line. If the HV control ECU
detects an open or short malfunction of the GSDN signal circuit, the HV control ECU illuminates the MIL
and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A7A (INF 342 / 343 / 519):
Generator inverter / Generator gate shutdown signal malfunction
Required sensor / components
Generator inverter
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
1 driving cycle
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Generator gate shutdown signal circuit
Open or short
HV
HV–312
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Generator inverter
DTC P0A7A (INF 342 / 343 / 519) is not detected
WIRING DIAGRAM
(Shielded)
Inverter
20
I10
GSDN
R
A
HV Control ECU
16
H15 GSDN
J5
J/C
IK
A092105E05
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HV
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - INVERTER)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–313
(c) Disconnect the H15 HV control ECU connector.
(d) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
H15
GSDN
HV Control ECU Connector
A065744E34
Wire Harness Side:
I10
I10
GSDN
Inverter Connector
A092041E22
(e) Disconnect the I10 inverter connector.
(f) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(g) Measure the voltage between the terminal of the HV
control ECU connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
GSDN (H15-16) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(h) Turn the power switch OFF.
(i) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
GSDN (H15-16) - GSDN (I10-20)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
GSDN (H15-16) or GSDN (I10-20) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(j)
(k)
(l)
(m)
Reconnect the inverter connector.
Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
HV
HV–314
DTC
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
P0A7A344
Generator Inverter Performance
DESCRIPTION
See the description of the inverter (see page HV-220).
The HV control ECU controls MG1 torque in accordance with the driving condition.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A7A
344
Failure in monitoring MG1 torque
performance
•
•
Hybrid vehicle generator
Inverter with converter
assembly
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
If the difference between the requested MG1 torque and the actual MG1 torque exceeds a predetermined
value, the HV control ECU determines that there is a malfunction in the execution or monitoring of the
MG1 torque. Then, the HV control ECU illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
HV
Related DTCs
P0A7A (INF 344):
Generator inverter / Discrepancy between generator monitored torque
and commanded torque
Required sensor / components
Generator inverter
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
No other condition
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Difference between demanded and actual MG1 torque
Exceeds the standard level
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Generator inverter
DTC P0A7A (INF 344) is not detected
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
1
HV–315
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV ECU)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTC P0A7A (INF 344) and other DTCs are output
HINT:
If any other codes besides P0A7A (INF 344) are output,
perform troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
YES
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
NO
2
INSPECT HYBRID VEHICLE GENERATOR ASSEMBLY
Hybrid Vehicle Generator:
I15
V
W
U
A092046E03
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
(d) Disconnect the three-phase alternating current cable for
the hybrid vehicle generator from the inverter.
(e) Using a milliohm meter, measure the resistance between
the three-phase alternating current cable terminals of the
hybrid vehicle generator.
NOTICE:
If the generator temperature is too high, the
resistance varies considerably, which hinders
determining malfunction. Therefore, measure the
resistance at a minimum 8 hours after the vehicle
has been stopped.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition*
U (I15-1) - V (I15-2)
Below 109 mΩ at 20°C
V (I15-2) - W (I15-3)
Below 109 mΩ at 20°C
W (I15-3) - U (I15-1)
Below 109 mΩ at 20°C
*: Apply the formula given below to correct the
resistance.
R20 = Rt / {1 + 0.00393 x (T - 20)}
R20: Resistance converted to 20°C (mΩ)
Rt: Resistance between measured lines (mΩ)
HV
HV–316
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
T: Ambient air temperature during measurement (°C)
Calculate the difference between the maximum and
minimum resistance between terminals U - V, V - W, and
W - U.
Standard resistance:
Below 2 mΩ
(g) Using a megohmmeter, measure the insulation
resistance between the three-phase alternating current
cable terminals of the hybrid vehicle generator and the
body ground.
Standard resistance
(f)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
U (I15-1) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
V (I15-2) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
W (I15-3) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
(h) Reconnect the three-phase alternating current cable for
the hybrid vehicle generator.
(i) Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
(j) Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE GENERATOR
ASSEMBLY
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
HV
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A7A520
HV–317
Generator Inverter Performance
DESCRIPTION
See the description of the inverter (see page HV-220).
Upon receiving a generator gate shutdown signal from the HV control ECU, the inverter forcefully stops
the operation of the MG1 by turning OFF the power transistors that are actuating the MG1.
The HV control ECU monitors the generator gate shutdown signal and detects a malfunction.
DTC No.
INF Code.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A7A
520
Generator gate shutdown
(GSDN) signal malfunction
•
•
Wire harness or connector
HV control ECU
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU monitors the generator gate shutdown (GSDN) signal. If the HV control ECU detects
a fault in the GSDN signal, it illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A7A (INF 520):
Generator inverter shutdown signal line malfunction
Required sensor / components
Generator inverter
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Actual status of shutdown command signal and its monitoring result
Inconsistent
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Generator inverter
DTC P0A7A (INF 520) is not detected
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0A7A (INF 342) (see page HV-310).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HV
HV–318
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV ECU)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTC P0A7A (INF 520) and other DTCs are output
HINT:
If any other codes besides P0A7A (INF 520) are output,
perform troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
YES
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
NO
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - INVERTER)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Disconnect the H15 HV control ECU connector.
(d) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
HV
H15
GSDN
HV Control ECU Connector
A065744E34
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Wire Harness Side:
I10
I10
GSDN
Inverter Connector
A092041E22
HV–319
(e) Disconnect the I10 inverter connector.
(f) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(g) Measure the voltage between the terminal of the HV
control ECU connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
GSDN (H15-16) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(h) Turn the power switch OFF.
(i) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
GSDN (H15-16) - GSDN (I10-20)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
GSDN (H15-16) or GSDN (I10-20) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(j)
(k)
(l)
(m)
Reconnect the inverter connector.
Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
OK
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
HV
HV–320
DTC
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
P0A7A522
Generator Inverter Performance
DESCRIPTION
See the description of the inverter (see page HV-220).
Upon receiving a generator gate shutdown signal from the HV control ECU, the inverter forcefully stops
the operation of the MG1 by turning OFF the power transistors that are actuating the MG1.
The HV control ECU monitors the generator inverter gate and detects a malfunction.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A7A
522
Generator inverter gate
malfunction
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A7A (INF 522): Malfunction of Inverter gate shutdown circuit
Required sensors / components
Generator inverter
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
HV
The monitor will run whenever the DTCs listed are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Generator inverter
DTC P0A7A (INF 522) is not detected
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0A7A (INF 342) (see page HV-310).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
1
HV–321
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - INVERTER)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Disconnect the H15 HV control ECU connector.
(d) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
H15
GSDN
HV Control ECU Connector
A065744E34
Wire Harness Side:
I10
I10
GSDN
Inverter Connector
A092041E22
(e) Disconnect the I10 inverter connector.
(f) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(g) Measure the voltage between the terminal of the HV
control ECU connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
GSDN (H15-16) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(h) Turn the power switch OFF.
(i) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
GSDN (H15-16) - GSDN (I10-20)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
GSDN (H15-16) or GSDN (I10-20) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(j)
(k)
(l)
(m)
Reconnect the inverter connector.
Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
HV
HV–322
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
HV
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A90239
Drive Motor "A" Performance
DTC
P0A90241
Drive Motor "A" Performance
DTC
P0A90602
Drive Motor "A" Performance
HV–323
DESCRIPTION
The HV transaxle consists of a planetary gear unit, MG1 and MG2.
A gear unit uses the planetary gear to split engine output in accordance with a driving request during
driving the vehicle or charging its internal HV battery.
The MG2 provides assistance to the engine output while increasing the drive force of the vehicle.
Furthermore, the MG2 effects regenerative braking by converting the energy (which is consumed in the
form of heat during normal braking) into electrical energy and recovering it into the HV battery. Through
regenerative braking, as well as decelerating the vehicle, the MG2 generates high-voltage electrical
power which is used for the purpose of charging the HV battery.
The MG1 supplies electrical power, which is used for charging the HV battery or for driving the MG2. It
also has a stepless transmission function to control the transaxle by regulating the amount of generation
of electrical energy, which effectively varies the MG1 speed. In addition, the MG1 is used as a starter
motor to start the engine.
The transmission input damper absorbs the shock that accompanies transmission of the drive force from
the engine.
HV
HV–324
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Planetary Gear Unit
MG2
MG1
Drive force from the engine
Oil Pump
Transmission Input Damper
Counter Gears
Final Gears
Different Gear Unit
HV
A092301E02
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A90
239
HV transaxle input malfunction
(shaft damaged)
•
•
•
•
•
P0A90
241
HV transaxle input malfunction
(torque limiter slipping)
•
•
•
•
•
P0A90
602
HV transaxle output malfunction
•
•
•
•
•
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0A0F (INF 238) (see page HV-135).
Engine assembly
HV transaxle assembly (shaft
or gear)
Transmission input damper
Wire harness or connector
HV control ECU
Engine assembly
HV transaxle assembly (shaft
or gear)
Transmission input damper
Wire harness or connector
HV control ECU
Engine assembly
HV transaxle assembly (shaft
or gear)
Transmission input damper
Wire harness or connector
HV control ECU
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–325
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ OUTPUT DTC (ENGINE)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / ENHANCED
OBD II / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTCs are output
YES
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
NO
2
CHECK CRANKSHAFT PULLEY REVOLUTION
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Jack up the vehicle.
(c) Manually turn the crankshaft pulley to check if the
crankshaft rotates.
OK:
The crankshaft rotates
NG
Go to step 10
OK
3
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (ECM - CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR)
(a) Disconnect the E4 ECM connector.
E4
NENE+
ECM Connector
A065743E70
(b) Disconnect the C7 crankshaft position sensor connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Wire Harness Side:
C7
Crankshaft Position Sensor Connector
A092031E01
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
NE+ (E4-33) - Crankshaft position
sensor (C7-1)
Below 1 Ω
NE- (E4-34) - Crankshaft position
sensor (C7-2)
Below 1 Ω
HV
HV–326
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
NE+ (E4-33) or Crankshaft position
sensor (C7-1) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NE- (E4-34) or Crankshaft position
sensor (C7-2) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(d) Reconnect the crankshaft position sensor connector.
(e) Reconnect the ECM connector.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - ECM)
(a) Disconnect the H16 HV control ECU connector.
H16
NEO
HV Control ECU Connector
A065745E37
(b) Disconnect the E7 ECM connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
E7
HV
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
NEO (H16-12) - NEO (E7-1)
Below 1 Ω
NEO
ECM Connector
A065744E24
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
NEO (H16-12) or NEO (E7-1) - Body
ground
10 Ω or higher
(d) Reconnect the ECM connector.
(e) Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
5
CHECK AND CLEAR DTC (HV ECU)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–327
(e) Check and record the DTCs, the freeze frame data, and
the information.
(f) Clear the DTCs of the HV ECU.
GO
6
CHECK READY LIGHT
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DATA LIST.
(e) Read the MG1 REV and ENGINE SPD values.
(f) Turn the power switch ON (READY).
OK:
READY light turns ON
HINT:
If the READY light does not turn ON, and the reading on
the intelligent tester shows DTC P0A90 (INF 239) (HV
transaxle input malfunction [shaft damaged]), or the MG1
turns but the engine does not crank, replace the hybrid
vehicle transaxle assembly.
NG
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE
ASSEMBLY
OK
7
CHECK ENGINE REV-UP
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DATA LIST.
(e) Read the MG1 REV and ENGINE SPD values.
(f) With the READY light turned ON, depress the
accelerator pedal for 10 seconds while the shift position
is in P.
OK:
The engine revs up
HINT:
If the engine does not rev up, and the reading on the
intelligent tester shows DTC P0A90 (INF 239) (HV
transaxle input malfunction [shaft damaged]), or the MG1
turns but the engine does not crank, replace the hybrid
vehicle transaxle assembly.
NG
OK
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE
ASSEMBLY
HV
HV–328
8
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK CREEP MOVEMENT
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (READY).
Jack up the vehicle.
Depress the brake pedal, move the selector lever to the
D position, and release the brake pedal.
OK:
The wheels turn (creep movement)
HINT:
If the wheels do not turn, and the reading on the
intelligent tester shows DTC P0A90 (INF 602) (HV
transaxle output malfunction), replace the hybrid vehicle
transaxle assembly.
NG
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE
ASSEMBLY
OK
9
CHECK ENGINE ACCELERATION SPEED
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) While driving at the vehicle speed of more than 6 mph
(10 km/h), fully depress the accelerator pedal to raise the
engine speed.
OK:
The engine speed increases smoothly
HINT:
If the engine over-revs or the reading on the intelligent
tester shows DTC P0A90 (INF 241) (HV transaxle input
malfunction [torque limiter slipping]), replace the
transmission input damper.
HV
NG
REPLACE TRANSMISSION INPUT DAMPER
ASSEMBLY
OK
PERFORM SIMULATION TEST. IF SYMPTOM IS NOT REPRODUCED, REPLACE HV TRANSAXLE
AND HV CONTROL ECU
10
CHECK FRONT TIRE REVOLUTION
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Depress the brake pedal, move the selector lever to the
N position.
(c) Jack up the vehicle.
(d) Manually turn the crankshaft pulley to check if the front
tires rotate.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–329
OK:
The front tires rotate
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE ENGINE ASSEMBLY
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
HV
HV–330
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A90240
Drive Motor "A" Performance
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0A90 (INF 239) (see page HV-321).
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A90
240
Generator locked
•
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
If the information (INF) code is present, replace the hybrid vehicle generator.
1
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE GENERATOR ASSEMBLY
NEXT
COMPLETED
HV
Hybrid vehicle generator
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A90242
HV–331
Drive Motor "A" Performance
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0A90 (INF 239) (see page HV-321).
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A90
242
Planetary gear locked
•
HV transaxle assembly
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
If the information (INF) code is present, replace the HV transaxle assembly.
1
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
(a) Replace the hybrid vehicle transaxle assembly (see
page HX-69).
NEXT
COMPLETED
HV
HV–332
DTC
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
P0A90251
Drive Motor "A" Performance
DESCRIPTION
When three-phase alternating current flows through the three-phase windings of the stator coil, a rotating
magnetic field is generated in the motor. The system controls the rotating magnetic field in accordance
with the rotating position and speed of the rotor. As a result, the permanent magnets provided on the rotor
are pulled in the rotating direction, which cause the generation of torque.
The generated torque is practically proportionate to the amount of current. Therefore, the system controls
the speed of the motor by regulating the frequency of the alternating current. Furthermore, the system
properly controls the rotating magnetic field and the angle of the rotor magnets in order to generate high
torque in an efficient manner, even at high speeds.
U Phase
#
Stator Coil
Rotor
Rotating Magnetic Field
Reaction
N
S
#
HV
W Phase
V Phase
: from inverter
#
Attraction
# : wired in motor
A093725E04
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A90
251
MG2 magnetic force deterioration
or same phase short circuit
•
Hybrid vehicle motor
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU monitors the hybrid vehicle motor (MG2). If the HV control ECU detects a reduction
in the magnetic force of the MG2 or an in-phase short, it interprets this as a MG2 failure. The HV control
ECU then illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A90 (INF 251):
Magnetic force deterioration/same phase short circuit
Required sensor / components
Hybrid vehicle motor, inverter, motor resolver
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–333
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Hybrid vehicle motor
DTC P0A90 (INF 251) is not detected
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV ECU)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTC P0A90 (INF 251) and other DTCs are output
HINT:
If any other codes besides P0A90 (INF 251) are output,
perform troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
YES
NO
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE MOTOR ASSEMBLY
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
HV
HV–334
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A90509
Drive Motor "A" Performance
DESCRIPTION
See the description of the MG1/MG2 (see page HV-330).
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A90
509
MG2 system malfunction
•
•
Hybrid vehicle motor
Inverter with converter
assembly
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU monitors the hybrid vehicle motor (MG2) system. If the HV control ECU detects a
malfunction in the MG2 system, it illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A90 (INF 509): Motor system malfunction
Required sensor / components
Hybrid vehicle motor, inverter, motor resolver
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
HV
The monitor will run whenever the following
TOYOTA's intellectual property
DTCs are not present No other condition
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Hybrid vehicle motor
DTC P0A90 (INF 509) is not detected
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV ECU)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–335
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTC P0A90 (INF 509) and other DTCs are output
HINT:
If any other codes besides P0A90 (INF 509) are output,
perform troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
YES
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
NO
2
INSPECT HYBRID VEHICLE MOTOR ASSEMBLY
Hybrid Vehicle Motor:
I14
U
V
W
A092045E02
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
(d) Disconnect the three-phase alternating current cable for
the hybrid vehicle motor from the inverter.
(e) Using a milliohm meter, measure the resistance between
the three-phase alternating current cable terminals of the
hybrid vehicle motor.
NOTICE:
If the motor temperature is too high, the resistance
varies considerably, which hinders determining
malfunction. Therefore, measure the resistance at a
minimum 8 hours after the vehicle has been
stopped.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition*
U (I14-1) - V (I14-2)
Below 135 mΩ at 20°C
V (I14-2) - W (I14-3)
Below 135 mΩ at 20°C
W (I14-3) - U (I14-1)
Below 135 mΩ at 20°C
(f)
*: Apply the formula given below to correct the
resistance.
R20 = Rt / {1 + 0.00393 x (T - 20)}
R20: Resistance converted to 20°C (mΩ)
Rt: Resistance between measured lines (mΩ)
T: Ambient air temperature during measurement (°C)
Calculate the difference between the maximum and
minimum resistance between terminals U - V, V - W, and
W - U.
HV
HV–336
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Standard resistance:
Below 2 mΩ
(g) Using a megohmmeter, measure the insulation
resistance between the three-phase alternating current
cable terminals of the hybrid vehicle motor and the body
ground.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
U (I14-1) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
V (I14-2) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
W (I14-3) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
(h) Reconnect the three-phase alternating current cable for
the hybrid vehicle motor.
(i) Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
(j) Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE MOTOR
ASSEMBLY
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
HV
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A90604
Drive Motor "A" Performance
DTC
P0A90605
Drive Motor "A" Performance
HV–337
DESCRIPTION
See the description of the MG1/MG2 (see page HV-330).
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A90
604
MG2 power balance malfunction
(small power balance)
•
•
Battery current sensor
Hybrid vehicle motor
P0A90
605
MG2 power balance malfunction
(large power balance)
•
•
Battery current sensor
Hybrid vehicle motor
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU monitors the energy balance of the hybrid vehicle motor (MG2) system. If the HV
control ECU detects a malfunction in the amount of electrical energy while the MG2 charges or
discharges electricity, it illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A90 (INF 604 / 605): Hybrid vehicle motor / Power balance
malfunction
Required sensor / components
Hybrid vehicle motor, motor resolver
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Hybrid vehicle motor (power balance)
Small or large
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Hybrid vehicle motor DTC P0A90 (INF 604 / 605) is not detected
DTC P0A90 (INF 604 / 605) is not detected
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HV
HV–338
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV BATTERY)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV BATTERY / DTC INFO / TROUBLE CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTCs are output
YES
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
NO
2
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV ECU)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTC P0A90 (INF 604 or 605) and other DTCs are
output
HINT:
If any other codes besides P0A90 (INF 604 or 605) are
output, perform troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
HV
YES
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
NO
3
INSPECT BATTERY CURRENT SENSOR
Component Side:
GIB
IB
VIB
Battery Current Sensor
A077580E03
(a) Remove the battery current sensor (see page HB-142).
(b) Measure the resistance between terminals 1 (VIB) and 2
(GIB).
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Positive probe to terminal 1 (VIB)
Negative probe to terminal 2 (GIB)
3.5 to 4.5 kΩ
Positive probe to terminal 2 (GIB)
Negative probe to terminal 1 (VIB)
5 to 7 kΩ or more
(c) Measure the resistance between terminals 1 (VIB) and 3
(IB).
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–339
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Positive probe to terminal 1 (VIB)
Negative probe to terminal 3 (IB)
3.5 to 4.5 kΩ
Positive probe to terminal 3 (IB)
Negative probe to terminal 1 (VIB)
5 to 7 kΩ or more
(d) Measure the resistance between terminals 2 (GIB) and 3
(IB).
Standard resistance:
0.2 kΩ or less
NOTICE:
Even if the probes are changed around, the
resistance will not vary.
(e) Reinstall the battery current sensor (see page HB-143).
NG
REPLACE BATTERY CURRENT SENSOR
OK
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE MOTOR ASSEMBLY
HV
HV–340
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A92261
Hybrid Generator Performance
DESCRIPTION
See the description of the MG1/MG2 (see page HV-330).
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A92
261
MG1 magnetic force deterioration
or same phase short circuit
•
Hybrid vehicle generator
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU monitors the hybrid vehicle generator (MG1). If the HV control ECU detects a
reduction in the magnetic force of the MG1 or an in-phase short, it interprets this as a MG1 failure. The HV
control ECU then illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A92 (INF 261):
Magnetic force deterioration/same phase short circuit
Required sensor / components
Hybrid vehicle generator, inverter, generator resolver
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
HV
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Hybrid vehicle generator
DTC P0A92 (INF 261) is not detected
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV ECU)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTC P0A92 (INF 261) and other DTCs are output
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–341
HINT:
If any other codes besides P0A92 (INF 261) are output,
perform troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
YES
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
NO
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE GENERATOR ASSEMBLY
HV
HV–342
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A92521
Hybrid Generator Performance
DESCRIPTION
See the description of the MG1/MG2 (see page HV-330).
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A92
521
MG1 system malfunction
•
•
Hybrid vehicle generator
Inverter with converter
assembly
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU monitors the hybrid vehicle generator (MG1) system. If the HV control ECU detects a
malfunction in the MG1 system, it illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A92 (INF 521):
Generator system malfunction
Required sensor / components
Hybrid vehicle generator, inverter, generator resolver
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
No other condition
-
HV
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Hybrid vehicle generator
DTC P0A92 (INF 521) is not detected
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV ECU)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–343
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTC P0A92 (INF 521) and other DTCs are output
HINT:
If any other codes besides P0A92 (INF 521) are output,
perform troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
YES
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
NO
2
INSPECT HYBRID VEHICLE GENERATOR ASSEMBLY
Hybrid Vehicle Generator:
I15
V
W
U
A092046E03
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
(d) Disconnect the three-phase alternating current cable for
the hybrid vehicle generator from the inverter.
(e) Using milliohm meter, measure the resistance between
the three-phase alternating current cable terminals of the
hybrid vehicle generator.
NOTICE:
If the generator temperature is too high, the
resistance varies considerably, which hinders
determining malfunction. Therefore, measure the
resistance at a minimum 8 hours after the vehicle
has been stopped.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition*
U (I15-1) - V (I15-2)
Below 109 mΩ at 20°C
V (I15-2) - W (I15-3)
Below 109 mΩ at 20°C
W (I15-3) - U (I15-1)
Below 109 mΩ at 20°C
(f)
*: Apply the formula given below to correct the
resistance.
R20 = Rt / {1 + 0.00393 x (T - 20)}
R20: Resistance converted to 20°C (mΩ)
Rt: Resistance between measured lines (mΩ)
T: Ambient air temperature during measurement (°C)
Calculate the difference between the maximum and
minimum resistance between terminals U - V, V - W, and
W - U.
HV
HV–344
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Standard resistance:
Below 2 mΩ
(g) Using a megohmmeter, measure the insulation
resistance between the three-phase alternating current
cable terminals of the hybrid vehicle generator and the
body ground.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
U (I15-1) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
V (I15-2) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
W (I15-3) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
(h) Reconnect the three-phase alternating current cable for
the hybrid vehicle generator.
(i) Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
(j) Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE GENERATOR
ASSEMBLY
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
HV
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A92606
Hybrid Generator Performance
DTC
P0A92607
Hybrid Generator Performance
HV–345
DESCRIPTION
See the description of the MG1/MG2 (see page HV-330).
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A92
606
MG1 power balance malfunction
(small power balance)
•
•
Battery current sensor
Hybrid vehicle generator
P0A92
607
MG1 power balance malfunction
(large power balance)
•
•
Battery current sensor
Hybrid vehicle generator
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU monitors the energy balance of the hybrid vehicle generator (MG1) system. If the HV
control ECU detects a malfunction in the amount of electrical energy while the MG1 charges or
discharges electricity, it illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A92 (INF 606 / 607):
Hybrid vehicle generator / Power balance malfunction
Required sensor / components
Hybrid vehicle generator, generator resolver
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Hybrid vehicle generator (power balance)
Small or large
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Hybrid vehicle generator
DTC P0A92 (INF 606 / 607) is not detected
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HV
HV–346
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV BATTERY)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV BATTERY / DTC INFO / TROUBLE CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTCs are output
YES
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
NO
2
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV ECU)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTC P0A92 (INF 606 or 607) and other DTCs are
output
HINT:
If any other codes besides P0A92 (INF 606 or 607) are
output, perform troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
HV
YES
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
NO
3
INSPECT BATTERY CURRENT SENSOR
Component Side:
GIB
IB
VIB
Battery Current Sensor
A077580E03
(a) Remove the battery current sensor (see page HB-142).
(b) Measure the resistance between terminals 1 (VIB) and 2
(GIB).
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Positive probe to terminal 1 (VIB)
Negative probe to terminal 2 (GIB)
3.5 to 4.5 kΩ
Positive probe to terminal 2 (GIB)
Negative probe to terminal 1 (VIB)
5 to 7 kΩ or more
(c) Measure the resistance between terminals 1 (VIB) and 3
(IB).
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–347
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Positive probe to terminal 1 (VIB)
Negative probe to terminal 3 (IB)
3.5 to 4.5 kΩ
Positive probe to terminal 3 (IB)
Negative probe to terminal 1 (VIB)
5 to 7 kΩ or more
(d) Measure the resistance between terminals 2 (GIB) and 3
(IB).
Standard resistance:
0.2 kΩ or less
NOTICE:
Even if the probes are changed around, the
resistance will not vary.
(e) Reinstall the battery current sensor (see page HB-143).
NG
REPLACE BATTERY CURRENT SENSOR
OK
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE GENERATOR ASSEMBLY
HV
HV–348
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A93346
Inverter Cooling System Performance
DTC
P0A93347
Inverter Cooling System Performance
DESCRIPTION
The inverter converts the high-voltage direct current of the HV battery into the alternating current for the
MG1 and the MG2. The inverter generates heat during the conversion process, and this heat could
damage the inverter if a cooling system is unavailable. Therefore, similar to the MG1 and the MG2, the
inverter is cooled by a dedicated cooling system, which consists of an electric water pump, cooling fan,
and radiator. This cooling system is independent of the engine cooling system.
Reservoir Tank
Water Pump
HV
Radiator
A092091E01
The HV control ECU monitors the electric water pump, cooling fan and cooling system, and detects a
malfunction.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A93
346
Inverter cooling system
malfunction (water pump system
malfunction)
•
•
•
•
•
•
P0A93
347
Inverter cooling system
malfunction (electric cooling fan
system malfunction)
•
•
•
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter cooling system
Water pump with motor
assembly
Cooling fan motor
No. 2 cooling fan motor
Inverter with converter
assembly
Wire harness or connector
Inverter cooling system
Water pump with motor
assembly
Cooling fan motor
No. 2 cooling fan motor
Inverter with converter
assembly
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–349
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
If the HV control ECU detects a malfunction in the electric water pump, fan, or radiator, it illuminates the
MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A93 (INF 346 / 347):
Inverter cooling system performance / Inverter cooling system
Required sensor / components
Water pump, radiator fan, inverter, boost converter, DC / DC converter
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
No other condition
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Water pump
Radiator fan
DTC P0A93 (INF 346 / 347) is not detected
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HV
1
CHECK QUANTITY OF HV COOLANT
(a) Check that there is a sufficient amount of coolant for the
inverter.
OK:
There is a sufficient amount of coolant for the
inverter
NG
ADD HV COOLANT
OK
2
CHECK COOLANT HOSE
(a) Check that the hoses of the cooling system are not bent
or clogged (refer to the cooling system).
OK:
The hoses of the cooling system are not bent or
clogged
NG
CORRECT TO NORMAL CONDITION
HV–350
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
OK
3
CHECK CONNECTION CONDITION OF WATER PUMP CONNECTOR (LOOSENESS AND
POOR CONTACT)
(a) Check the connection condition of the water pump
connector.
OK:
Connector has been connected securely and there
is no poor connection.
NG
CONNECT SECURELY
A090415E01
OK
4
CHECK WATER PUMP WITH MOTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Check the operation of the water pump.
OK:
Coolant is sloshing in the reservoir tank
NG
REPLACE WATER PUMP WITH MOTOR
ASSEMBLY
OK
HV
5
CHECK CONNECTION CONDITION OF COOLING FAN MOTOR CONNECTOR
(LOOSENESS AND POOR CONTACT)
(a) Check the connection condition of the cooling fan motor
connectors.
OK:
Connectors have been connected securely and
there is no poor connection.
NG
CONNECT SECURELY
A090546E01
OK
6
INSPECT COOLING FAN MOTOR
(a) Inspect the cooling fan motor (see page CO-5).
NG
REPLACE COOLING FAN MOTOR AND ADD
ENGINE COOLANT
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–351
OK
7
INSPECT NO. 2 COOLING FAN MOTOR
(a) Inspect the No. 2 cooling fan motor (see page CO-5).
NG
REPLACE NO. 2 COOLING FAN MOTOR AND
ADD ENGINE COOLANT
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
HV
HV–352
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A94442
DC / DC Converter Performance
DESCRIPTION
The boost converter contains a booster IPM (Intelligent Power Module), which includes an IGBT
(Insulated Gate Bipolar Transistor) and a reactor. The HV control ECU actuates the IGBT, which controls
the current in the reactor.
The boost converter boosts the high-voltage direct current rated at 201.6 V to an approximate direct
current voltage of 500 V. The inverter converts the voltage that has been boosted by the boost converter
into alternating current, which is used for driving the MG1/MG2. When the MG1/MG2 operates as a
generator, the alternating current of approximately 500 V from the MG1/MG2 is converted into direct
current by the inverter.
Then, the boost converter drops this voltage to a direct current voltage rated at 201.6 V in order to charge
the HV battery.
Boost Converter
Inverter Assembly
Inverter
Booster
IPM
HV Battery
MG1/
MG2
Reactor
HV
Voltage Conversion
Before boosting
direct current
After boosting
direct current
After converting
alternating current
A093726E02
The HV control ECU uses a voltage sensor that is built into the boost converter to detect the high voltage
(VL) before it is boosted. Also, it uses a voltage sensor that is built into the inverter to detect the high
voltage (VH) after it has been boosted.
Based on the voltage before and after it has been boosted, the HV control ECU boosts it to a target
voltage by controlling the operation of the boost converter.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A94
442
Abnormal voltage execution value
•
Inverter with converter
assembly
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–353
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV ECU)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTC P0A94 (INF 442) and other DTCs are output
HINT:
If any other codes besides P0A94 (INF 442) are output,
perform troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
YES
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
NO
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
HV
HV–354
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A94545
DC / DC Converter Performance
DTC
P0A94546
DC / DC Converter Performance
DESCRIPTION
See the description of the boost converter (see page HV-350).
If the boost converter detects a circuit malfunction or over-voltage, the boost converter transmits this
information to the OVL terminal of the HV control ECU via the boost converter over-voltage signal line.
The HV control ECU monitors the boost converter over-voltage signal line and detects a malfunction.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A94
545
Open or GND short in boost
converter over-voltage (OVL)
signal circuit
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0A94
546
+B short in boost converter overvoltage (OVL) signal circuit
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU monitors the boost converter over-voltage (OVL) signal line. If the HV control ECU
detects an open or short malfunction of the OVL signal circuit, the HV control ECU illuminates the MIL and
sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
HV
Related DTCs
P0A94 (INF 545 / 546): Boost converter / Converter OVL detection
Required sensor / components
Boost converter
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Boost converter over-voltage (OVL) signal circuit
Open or short
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Boost converter
DTC P0A94 (INF 545 / 546) is not detected
HV–355
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
HV Control ECU
Inverter
31
I10
OVL
22
H16 OVL
B
(Shielded)
32
GCNV I10
8
H16 GCNV
G
A
J5
J/C
IK
A092102E09
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - INVERTER)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Disconnect the H16 HV control ECU connector.
(d) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
H16
GCNV
CPWM
HV Control ECU Connector
A065745E41
HV
HV–356
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Wire Harness Side:
I10
GCNV
I10
Inverter Connector
OVL
A092041E44
(e) Disconnect the I10 inverter connector.
(f) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(g) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the HV
control ECU connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
OVL (H16-22) - Body ground
Below 1 V
GCNV (H16-8) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(h) Turn the power switch OFF.
(i) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
OVL (H16-22) - OVL (I10-31)
Below 1 Ω
GCNV (H16-8) - GCNV (I10-32)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
OVL (H16-22) or OVL (I10-31) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
GCNV (H16-8) or GCNV (I10-32) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(j)
(k)
(l)
(m)
HV
Reconnect the inverter connector.
Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A94547
DC / DC Converter Performance
DTC
P0A94548
DC / DC Converter Performance
DTC
P0A94549
DC / DC Converter Performance
HV–357
DESCRIPTION
See the description of the booster converter (see page HV-350).
If the boost converter detects a circuit malfunction or over-voltage, the boost converter transmits that
information to the OVL terminal of the HV control ECU via the boost converter over-voltage signal line.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A94
547
Boost converter over-voltage
(OVL) signal detection (overvoltage by HV control ECU
malfunction)
•
•
•
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
HV transaxle assembly
Hybrid vehicle motor
Hybrid vehicle generator
HV control ECU
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0A94
548
Boost converter over-voltage
(OVL) signal detection (overvoltage by inverter assembly
malfunction)
•
•
•
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
HV transaxle assembly
Hybrid vehicle motor
Hybrid vehicle generator
HV control ECU
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0A94
549
Boost converter over-voltage
(OVL) signal detection (overvoltage by HV transaxle assembly
malfunction)
•
•
•
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
HV transaxle assembly
Hybrid vehicle motor
Hybrid vehicle generator
HV control ECU
Inverter with converter
assembly
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
If the boost converter detects over-voltage, it transmits a boost converter over-voltage signal to the HV
control ECU. Upon receiving this signal, the HV control ECU illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A94 (INF 547 / 548 / 549):
OVL detection over-voltage
Required sensor / components
Boost converter
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
HV
HV–358
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Boost converter
Over-voltage
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Boost converter
DTC P0A94 (INF 547 / 548 / 549) is not detected
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0A78 (INF 279) (see page HV-235).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
CONFIRM INFORMATION (EXCLUSIVE INFO 3)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Select DTC P0A94 to display its freeze frame data.
(f) Select the item that has INF code 547, 548, or 549 from
among INFORMATION 1 to 5, and press ENTER.
(g) Read EXCLUSIVE INFO 3.
Result:
-32 to 32 (during driving without battery power)
HINT:
If the value is inside the range shown above, DTCs other than
P0A78 (INF 547, 548 and 549) have been detected as well.
Perform troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
HV
YES
NO
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
2
HV–359
CHECK CONNECTION CONDITION OF HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU CONNECTOR
(LOOSENESS AND POOR CONTACT)
(a) Check the connection condition of all the connectors at
the HV control ECU.
OK:
Connectors have been connected securely and
there is no poor connection.
NG
CONNECT SECURELY
HV Control ECU Connector
A093719E09
OK
3
CHECK CONNECTION CONDITION OF INVERTER CONNECTOR (LOOSENESS AND
POOR CONTACT)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
(d) Check the connection condition of the I9 and I10 inverter
connectors.
(e) Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
(f) Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
I10
NG
I9
CONNECT SECURELY
Inverter Connector
A092044E02
OK
4
CONFIRM INFORMATION (EXCLUSIVE INFO 4)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(c) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
HV
HV–360
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Select DTC P0A94 to display its freeze frame data.
(f) Select the item that has INF code 547, 548, or 549 from
among INFORMATION 1 to 5, and press ENTER.
(g) Read EXCLUSIVE INFO 4.
Result:
Displayed in Exclusive Information 4
Proceed to
-127 to -120, -95 to -88, -63 to -56, -31 to -24, 1 to 8, 33 to 40, 65 to
72, 97 to 104
A
-119 to -112, -87 to -80, -55 to -48, -23 to -16, 9 to 16, 41 to 48, 73 to
80, 105 to 112
B
-111 to -104, -79 to -72, -47 to -40, -15 to -8, 17 to 24, 49 to 56, 81 to
88, 113 to 120
C
-103 to -96, -71 to -64, -39 to -32, -7 to 0, 25 to 32, 57 to 64, 89 to 96,
121 to 127
D
B
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
C
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
D
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE
ASSEMBLY
A
5
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV ECU)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(c) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
HV
DTC No.
INF Code
Detection Item
See Page
P0A78
266
Drive Motor "A" Inverter
Performance
HV-220
P0A94
558 or 560
DC / DC Converter Performance
HV-389
P0A94
588
DC / DC Converter Performance
HV-409
P0A94
589
DC / DC Converter Performance
HV-412
P0ADB
227
Hybrid Battery Positive Contactor
Control Circuit Low
HV-439
P0ADF
229
Hybrid Battery Negative
Contactor Control Circuit Low
HV-441
P3000
125
HV Battery Malfunction
HV-466
P3004
131
Power Cable Malfunction
HV-470
YES
GO TO THE PAGE NUMBER SHOWN IN THE
TABLE ABOVE
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–361
NO
6
INSPECT HYBRID VEHICLE MOTOR ASSEMBLY
Hybrid Vehicle Motor:
I14
U
V
W
A092045E02
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
(d) Disconnect the three-phase alternating current cable for
the hybrid vehicle motor from the inverter.
(e) Using a milliohm meter, measure the resistance between
the three-phase alternating current cable terminals of the
hybrid vehicle motor.
NOTICE:
If the motor temperature is too high, the resistance
varies considerably, which hinders determining
malfunction. Therefore, measure the resistance at a
minimum 8 hours after the vehicle has been
stopped.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition*
U (I14-1) - V (I14-2)
Below 135 mΩ at 20°C
V (I14-2) - W (I14-3)
Below 135 mΩ at 20°C
W (I14-3) - U (I14-1)
Below 135 mΩ at 20°C
*: Apply the formula given below to correct the
resistance.
R20 = Rt / {1 + 0.00393 x (T - 20)}
R20: Resistance converted to 20°C (mΩ)
Rt: Resistance between measured lines (mΩ)
T: Ambient air temperature during measurement (°C)
(f) Calculate the difference between the maximum and
minimum resistance between terminals U - V, V - W, and
W - U.
Standard resistance:
Below 2 mΩ
(g) Using a megohmmeter, measure the insulation
resistance between the three-phase alternating current
cable terminals of the hybrid vehicle motor and the body
ground.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
U (I14-1) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
V (I14-2) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
W (I14-3) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
HV
HV–362
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
(h) Reconnect the three-phase alternating current cable for
the hybrid vehicle motor.
NG
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE MOTOR
ASSEMBLY
OK
7
INSPECT HYBRID VEHICLE GENERATOR ASSEMBLY
Hybrid Vehicle Generator:
I15
V
W
U
A092046E03
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Check that the service plug grip and inverter cover have
been removed.
(b) Disconnect the three-phase alternating current cable for
the hybrid vehicle generator from the inverter.
(c) Using a milliohm meter, measure the resistance between
the three-phase alternating current cable terminals of the
hybrid vehicle generator.
NOTICE:
If the generator temperature is too high, the
resistance varies considerably, which hinders
determining malfunction. Therefore, measure the
resistance at a minimum 8 hours after the vehicle
has been stopped.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
HV
Specified Condition*
U (I15-1) - V (I15-2)
Below 109 mΩ at 20°C
V (I15-2) - W (I15-3)
Below 109 mΩ at 20°C
W (I15-3) - U (I15-1)
Below 109 mΩ at 20°C
*: Apply the formula given below to correct the
resistance.
R20 = Rt / {1 + 0.00393 x (T - 20)}
R20: Resistance converted to 20°C (mΩ)
Rt: Resistance between measured lines (mΩ)
T: Ambient air temperature during measurement (°C )
(d) Calculate the difference between the maximum and
minimum resistance between terminals U - V, V - W, and
W - U.
Standard resistance:
Below 2 mΩ
(e) Using a megohmmeter, measure the insulation
resistance between the three-phase alternating current
cable terminals of the hybrid vehicle generator and the
body ground.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
U (I15-1) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
V (I15-2) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
W (I15-3) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
(f)
HV–363
Reconnect the three-phase alternating current cable for
the hybrid vehicle generator.
NG
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE GENERATOR
ASSEMBLY
OK
8
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (INVERTER STOP)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Check that the service plug grip and inverter cover have
been removed.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(d) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(e) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / ACTIVE TEST.
(f) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the
inverter connector while effecting INVERTER STOP.
Standard voltage
I10
Tester Connection
GUU GVU GWU MUU MVU MWU
I10
Specified Condition
MUU (I10-9) - GINV (I10-16)
12 to 16 V
MVU (I10-10) - GINV (I10-16)
12 to 16 V
MWU (I10-11) - GINV (I10-16)
12 to 16 V
GUU (I10-4) - GINV (I10-16)
12 to 16 V
GVU (I10-5) - GINV (I10-16)
12 to 16 V
GWU (I10-6) - GINV (I10-16)
12 to 16 V
(g) Turn the power switch OFF.
GINV
Inverter Connector
A093730E07
OK
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
AND INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
NG
9
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (INVERTER STOP)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Check that the service plug grip and inverter cover have
been removed.
HV
HV–364
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
I10
GUU GVU GWU MUU MVU MWU
I10
GINV
Inverter Connector
A093731E05
(b) Disconnect the I10 inverter connector.
(c) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(e) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(f) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / ACTIVE TEST.
(g) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the
inverter connector while effecting INVERTER STOP.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
MUU (I10-9) - GINV (I10-16)
14 to 16 V
MVU (I10-10) - GINV (I10-16)
14 to 16 V
MWU (I10-11) - GINV (I10-16)
14 to 16 V
GUU (I10-4) - GINV (I10-16)
14 to 16 V
GVU (I10-5) - GINV (I10-16)
14 to 16 V
GWU (I10-6) - GINV (I10-16)
14 to 16 V
(h)
(i)
(j)
(k)
Turn the power switch OFF.
Reconnect the inverter connector.
Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
OK
HV
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A94550
HV–365
DC / DC Converter Performance
DESCRIPTION
See the description of the boost converter (see page HV-350).
If the boost converter detects a circuit malfunction or over-voltage, the boost converter transmits that
information to the OVL terminal of the HV control ECU via the boost converter over-voltage signal line.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A94
550
Boost converter over-voltage
(OVL) signal detection (circuit
malfunction)
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
If the boost converter detects a circuit malfunction, it transmits a boost converter over-voltage signal to the
HV control ECU. Upon receiving this signal, the HV control ECU illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A94 (INF 550): OVL detection circuit malfunction
Required sensor / components
Boost converter
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Boost converter
Circuit malfunction
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Boost converter
DTC P0A94 (INF 550) is not detected
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0A78 (INF 282) (see page HV-244).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
HV
HV–366
1
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV ECU)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTC listed in the table below is output
DTC No.
INF Code Detection
Item
See Page
P0A94
545 or 546
DC / DC Converter Malfunction
HV-352
YES
GO TO THE PAGE NUMBER SHOWN IN THE
TABLE ABOVE
NO
2
CHECK CONNECTION CONDITION OF INVERTER CONNECTOR (LOOSENESS AND
POOR CONTACT)
HV
I10
I9
Inverter Connector
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
(d) Check the connection condition of the I9 and I10 inverter
connectors.
OK:
Connectors have been connected securely and
there is no poor connection.
(e) Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
(f) Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
CONNECT SECURELY
A092044E02
OK
3
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV ECU)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–367
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(c) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTCs P0A78 (INF 282, 286) and P0A7A (INF 324)
(inverter circuit malfunction) are output
NO
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
YES
4
CHECK INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY (IGCT VOLTAGE)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(e) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the
inverter connector.
Standard voltage
I9
Inverter Connector
GND1(-)
IGCT (+)
A093729E02
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
IGCT (I9-1) - GND1 (I9-2)
8 V or more
(f) Turn the power switch OFF.
(g) Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
(h) Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
HV
HV–368
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A94551
DC / DC Converter Performance
DTC
P0A94552
DC / DC Converter Performance
DESCRIPTION
See the description of the boost converter (see page HV-350).
If the boost converter has a circuit malfunction, or internal short, or overheats, the boost converter
transmits this information to the FCV terminal of the HV control ECU via the boost converter fail signal
line.
The HV control ECU monitors the boost converter fail signal line and detects a malfunction.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A94
551
Open or GND short in boost
converter fail (FCV) signal circuit
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0A94
552
+B short in boost converter fail
(FCV) signal circuit
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU monitors the boost converter fail (FCV) signal line. If the HV control ECU detects an
open or short malfunction of the FCV signal circuit, the HV control ECU illuminates the MIL and sets a
DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
HV
Related DTCs
P0A94 (INF 551 / 552): Boost converter / Converter Finv detection
Required sensor / components
Boost converter
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
1 driving cycle
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Boost converter fail signal circuit
Open or short
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Boost converter
DTC P0A94 (INF 551 / 552) is not detected
HV–369
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
HV Control ECU
Inverter
30
I10
FCV
20
H16 FCV
W
(Shielded)
32
GCNV I10
8
H16 GCNV
G
A
J5
J/C
IK
A092102E10
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
HINT: At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - INVERTER)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Disconnect the H16 HV control ECU connector.
(d) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
H16
GCNV
FCV
HV Control ECU Connector
A065745E50
HV
HV–370
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Wire Harness Side
I10
FCV
(e) Disconnect the I10 inverter connector.
(f) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(g) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the HV
control ECU connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
I10
Inverter Connector
GINV
A092041E45
Specified Condition
FCV (H16-20) - Body ground
Below 1 V
GCNV (H16-8) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(h) Turn the power switch OFF.
(i) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
FCV (H16-20) - FCV (I10-30)
Below 1 Ω
GCNV (H16-8) - GCNV (I10-32)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
FCV (H16-20) or FCV (I10-30) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
GCNV (H16-8) or GCNV (I10-32) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(j)
(k)
(l)
(m)
HV
Reconnect the inverter connector.
Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A94553
HV–371
DC / DC Converter Performance
DESCRIPTION
See the description of the boost converter (see page HV-350).
If the boost converter has a circuit malfunction, internal short, or overheats, the boost converter transmits
that information to the FCV terminal of the HV control ECU via the boost converter fail signal line.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A94
553
Boost converter fail (FCV) signal
detection (boost converter
overheating)
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter cooling system
Water pump with motor
assembly
Cooling fan motor
No. 2 cooling fan motor
HV transaxle assembly
Hybrid vehicle motor
Hybrid vehicle generator
HV control ECU
Inverter with converter
assembly
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
If the boost converter is overheated, it transmits a boost converter fail signal to the HV control ECU. Upon
receiving this signal, the HV control ECU illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A94 (INF 553): FCV detection over heat
Required sensor / components
Boost converter
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Boost converter
Overheated
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Boost converter
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0A78 (INF 279) (see page HV-235).
DTC P0A94 (INF 553) is not detected
HV
HV–372
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV ECU)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTCs listed in the table below are output
DTC No.
HV
Relevant Diagnosis
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
P0A2B, P0A2C or P0A2D
Drive Motor "A" Temperature Sensor Circuit System
P0A37, P0A38 or P0A39
Generator Temperature Sensor Circuit System
P0A3F, P0A40 or P0A4
Drive Motor "A" Position Sensor Circuit System
P0A4B, P0A4C or P0A4D
Generator Position Sensor Circuit System
P0A60 or P0A63
Drive Motor "A" Current Sensor Circuit System
P0A72 or P0A75
Generator Current Sensor Circuit System
P0A78
Drive Motor "A" Inverter Performance
P0A7A
Generator Inverter Performance
P0A90
Drive Motor "A" Performance
P0A92
Hybrid Generator Performance
P0A93
Inverter Cooling System Malfunction
P0A94
DC / DC Converter Malfunction
P0AA1, P0AA4, P0AE0, P0AE6, P0AE7, P0ADB or P0ADF
System Main Relay Circuit System
P0AA6, P3004
High Voltage System
P0AEE
Motor Inverter Temperature Sensor Malfunction
P3000
HV Battery System Malfunction
P3110
Integration Relay Malfunction
P3221
Generator Inverter Temperature Sensor Circuit System
P3226
DC / DC Boost Converter Temperature Sensor Circuit System
YES
NO
GO TO DTC CHART. FIND PAGE NUMBER
TO PROCEED TO DIAGNOSTIC
TROUBLESHOOTING FLOWCHART
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
2
HV–373
CHECK QUANTITY OF HV COOLANT
(a) Check that there is a sufficient amount of coolant for the
inverter.
OK:
There is a sufficient amount of coolant for the
inverter
NG
ADD HV COOLANT
OK
3
CHECK COOLANT HOSE
(a) Check that the hoses of the cooling system are not bent
or clogged (refer to the cooling system [see page HV346]).
OK:
The hoses of the cooling system are not bent or
clogged
NG
CORRECT TO NORMAL CONDITION
OK
4
CHECK CONNECTION CONDITION OF WATER PUMP CONNECTOR (LOOSENESS AND
POOR CONTACT)
(a) Check the connection condition of the water pump
connector.
OK:
Connector has been connected securely and there
is no poor connection.
NG
CONNECT SECURELY
A090415E02
OK
5
CHECK WATER PUMP WITH MOTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Check the operation of the water pump.
OK:
Coolant is sloshing in the reservoir tank
NG
REPLACE WATER PUMP WITH MOTOR
ASSEMBLY
HV
HV–374
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
OK
6
CHECK CONNECTION CONDITION OF COOLING FAN MOTOR CONNECTOR
(LOOSENESS AND POOR CONTACT)
(a) Check the connection condition of the cooling fan motor
connectors.
OK:
Connectors have been connected securely and
there is no poor connection.
NG
CONNECT SECURELY
A090546E01
OK
7
INSPECT COOLING FAN MOTOR
(a) Inspect the cooling fan motor (see page CO-5).
NG
REPLACE COOLING FAN MOTOR AND ADD
ENGINE COOLANT
OK
8
INSPECT NO. 2 COOLING FAN MOTOR
HV
(a) Inspect the No. 2 cooling fan motor (see page CO-5).
NG
REPLACE NO. 2 COOLING FAN MOTOR AND
ADD ENGINE COOLANT
OK
9
CHECK CONNECTION CONDITION OF HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU CONNECTOR
(LOOSENESS AND POOR CONTACT)
(a) Check the connection condition of all the connectors at
the HV control ECU.
OK:
Connectors have been connected securely and
there is no poor connection.
NG
HV Control ECU Connector
A093719E09
OK
CONNECT SECURELY
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
10
HV–375
CHECK CONNECTION CONDITION OF INVERTER CONNECTOR (LOOSENESS AND
POOR CONTACT)
I10
I9
Inverter Connector
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
(d) Check the connection condition of the I9 and I10 inverter
connectors.
OK:
Connectors have been connected securely and
there is no poor connection.
(e) Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
(f) Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
CONNECT SECURELY
A092044E02
OK
11
CONFIRM INFORMATION (EXCLUSIVE INFO 4)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(c) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Select DTC P0A94 to display its freeze frame data.
(f) Select the item that has INF code 553 from among
INFORMATION 1 to 5, and press ENTER.
(g) Read EXCLUSIVE INFO 4.
Result:
Displayed in Exclusive Information 4
Proceed to
-127 to -120, -95 to -88, -63 to -56, -31 to -24, 1 to 8, 33 to 40, 65 to
72, 97 to 104
A
-119 to -112, -87 to -80, -55 to -48, -23 to -16, 9 to 16, 41 to 48, 73 to
80, 105 to 112
B
-111 to -104, -79 to -72, -47 to -40, -15 to -8, 17 to 24, 49 to 56, 81 to
88, 113 to 120
C
-103 to -96, -71 to -64, -39 to -32, -7 to 0, 25 to 32, 57 to 64, 89 to 96,
121 to 127
D
HV
HV–376
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
B
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
C
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
D
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE
ASSEMBLY
A
12
INSPECT HYBRID VEHICLE MOTOR ASSEMBLY
Hybrid Vehicle Motor:
I14
U
V
HV
W
A092045E03
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
(d) Disconnect the three-phase alternating current cable for
the hybrid vehicle motor from the inverter.
(e) Using a milliohm meter, measure the resistance between
the three-phase alternating current cable terminals of the
hybrid vehicle motor.
NOTICE:
If the motor temperature is too high, the resistance
varies considerably, which hinders determining
malfunction. Therefore, measure the resistance at a
minimum 8 hours after the vehicle has been
stopped.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition*
U (I14-1) - V (I14-2)
Below 135 mΩ at 20°C
V (I14-2) - W (I14-3)
Below 135 mΩ at 20°C
W (I14-3) - U (I14-1)
Below 135 mΩ at 20°C
(f)
*: Apply the formula given below to correct the
resistance.
R20 = Rt / {1+ 0.00393 x (T - 20)}
R20: Resistance converted to 20°C (mΩ)
Rt: Resistance between measured lines (mΩ)
T: Ambient air temperature during measurement (°C)
Calculate the difference between the maximum and
minimum resistance between terminals U - V, V - W, and
W - U.
Standard resistance:
Below 2 mΩ
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–377
(g) Using a megohmmeter, measure the insulation
resistance between the three-phase alternating current
cable terminals of the hybrid vehicle motor and the body
ground.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
U (I14-1) - Body ground
10 MΩor higher
V (I14-2) - Body ground
10 MΩor higher
W (I14-3) - Body ground
10 MΩor higher
(h) Reconnect the three-phase alternating current cable for
the hybrid vehicle motor.
NG
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE MOTOR
ASSEMBLY
OK
13
INSPECT HYBRID VEHICLE GENERATOR ASSEMBLY
Hybrid Vehicle Generator:
I15
V
W
U
A092046E03
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Check that the service plug grip and inverter cover have
been removed.
(b) Disconnect the three-phase alternating current cable for
the hybrid vehicle generator from the inverter.
(c) Using a milliohm meter, measure the resistance between
the three-phase alternating current cable terminals of the
hybrid vehicle generator.
NOTICE:
If the generator temperature is too high, the
resistance varies considerably, which hinders
determining malfunction. Therefore, measure the
resistance at a minimum 8 hours after the vehicle
has been stopped.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition*
U (I15-1) - V (I15-2)
Below 109 mΩ at 20°C
V (I15-2) - W (I15-3)
Below 109 mΩ at 20°C
W (I15-3) - U (I15-1)
Below 109 mΩ at 20°C
*: Apply the formula given below to correct the
resistance.
R20 = Rt / {1 + 0.00393 x (T - 20)}
R20: Resistance converted to 20°C (mΩ)
Rt: Resistance between measured lines (mΩ)
T: Ambient air temperature during measurement (°C)
(d) Calculate the difference between the maximum and
minimum resistance between terminals U - V, V - W, and
W - U.
Standard resistance:
Below 2 Ω
HV
HV–378
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
(e) Using a megohmmeter, measure the insulation
resistance between the three-phase alternating current
cable terminals of the hybrid vehicle generator and the
body ground.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
U (I15-1) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
V (I15-2) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
W (I15-3) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
(f)
Reconnect the three-phase alternating current cable for
the hybrid vehicle generator.
NG
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
OK
14
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (INVERTER STOP)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Check that the service plug grip and inverter cover have
been removed.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(d) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(e) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / ACTIVE TEST.
(f) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the
inverter connector while effecting INVERTER STOP.
Standard voltage
HV
I10
GUU GVU GWU MUU MVU MWU
I10
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
MUU (I10-9) - GINV (I10-16)
12 to 16 V
MVU (I10-10) - GINV (I10-16)
12 to 16 V
MWU (I10-11) - GINV (I10-16)
12 to 16 V
GUU (I10-4) - GINV (I10-16)
12 to 16 V
GVU (I10-5) - GINV (I10-16)
12 to 16 V
GWU (I10-6) - GINV (I10-16)
12 to 16 V
(g) Turn the power switch OFF.
GINV
Inverter Connector
A093730E07
NG
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
15
HV–379
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (INVERTER STOP)
I10
GUU GVU GWU MUU MVU MWU
I10
GINV
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Check that the service plug grip and inverter cover have
been removed.
(b) Disconnect the I10 inverter connector.
(c) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(e) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(f) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / ACTIVE TEST.
(g) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the
inverter connector while effecting INVERTER STOP.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Inverter Connector
A093731E05
Specified Condition
MUU (I10-9) - GINV (I10-16)
14 to 16 V
MVU (I10-10) - GINV (I10-16)
14 to 16 V
MWU (I10-11) - GINV (I10-16)
14 to 16 V
GUU (I10-4) - GINV (I10-16)
14 to 16 V
GVU (I10-5) - GINV (I10-16)
14 to 16 V
GWU (I10-6) - GINV (I10-16)
14 to 16 V
(h)
(i)
(j)
(k)
Turn the power switch OFF.
Reconnect the inverter connector.
Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
OK
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
HV
HV–380
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A94554
DC / DC Converter Performance
DTC
P0A94555
DC / DC Converter Performance
DTC
P0A94556
DC / DC Converter Performance
DESCRIPTION
See the description of the boost converter (see page HV-350).
If the boost converter has a circuit malfunction, internal short, or overheats, the boost converter transmits
that information to the FCV terminal of the HV control ECU via the boost converter fail signal line.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A94
554
Boost converter fail (FCV) signal
detection (over current by HV
control ECU malfunction)
•
•
•
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
HV transaxle assembly
Hybrid vehicle motor
Hybrid vehicle generator
HV control ECU
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0A94
555
Boost converter fail (FCV) signal
detection (over current by inverter
assembly malfunction)
•
•
•
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
HV transaxle assembly
Hybrid vehicle motor
Hybrid vehicle generator
HV control ECU
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0A94
556
Boost converter fail (FCV) signal
detection (over current by HV
transaxle assembly malfunction)
•
•
•
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
HV transaxle assembly
Hybrid vehicle motor
Hybrid vehicle generator
HV control ECU
Inverter with converter
assembly
HV
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
If over-amperage flows through the boost converter due to an internal short, the boost converter transmits
a boost converter fail signal to the HV control ECU. Upon receiving this signal, the HV control ECU
illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A94 (INF 554 / 555 / 556):
FCV detection over current
Required sensor / components
Boost converter
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
HV–381
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Boost converter
Over current (internal short)
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Boost converter
DTC P0A94 (INF 554 / 555 / 556) is not detected
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0A78 (INF 279) (see page HV-235).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV ECU)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTCs listed in the table below are output
DTC No.
Relevant Diagnosis
P0A1D
Hybrid Powertrain Control Module
P0A2B, P0A2C or P0A2D
Drive Motor "A" Temperature Sensor Circuit System
P0A37, P0A38 or P0A39
Generator Temperature Sensor Circuit System
P0A3F, P0A40 or P0A4
Drive Motor "A" Position Sensor Circuit System
P0A4B, P0A4C or P0A4D
Generator Position Sensor Circuit System
P0A60 or P0A63
Drive Motor "A" Current Sensor Circuit System
P0A72 or P0A75
Generator Current Sensor Circuit System
P0A78
Drive Motor "A" Inverter Performance
P0A7A
Generator Inverter Performance
P0A90
Drive Motor "A" Performance
P0A92
Hybrid Generator Performance
P0A93
Inverter Cooling System Malfunction
P0A94
DC / DC Converter Malfunction
P0AA1, P0AA4, P0AE0, P0AE6, P0AE7, P0ADB or P0ADF
System Main Relay Circuit System
P0AA6, P3004
High Voltage System
P0AEE
Motor Inverter Temperature Sensor Malfunction
HV
HV–382
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC No.
Relevant Diagnosis
P3000
HV Battery System Malfunction
P3110
Integration Relay Malfunction
P3221
Generator Inverter Temperature Sensor Circuit System
P3226
DC / DC Boost Converter Temperature Sensor Circuit System
YES
GO TO DTC CHART. FIND PAGE NUMBER
TO PROCEED TO DIAGNOSTIC
TROUBLESHOOTING FLOWCHART.
NO
2
CHECK CONNECTION CONDITION OF HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU CONNECTOR
(LOOSENESS AND POOR CONTACT)
(a) Check the connection condition of all the connectors at
the HV control ECU.
OK:
Connectors have been connected securely and
there is no poor connection.
NG
CONNECT SECURELY
HV Control ECU Connector
A093719E09
OK
HV
3
CHECK CONNECTION CONDITION OF INVERTER CONNECTOR (LOOSENESS AND
POOR CONTACT)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
(d) Check the connection condition of the I9 and I10 inverter
connectors.
OK:
Connectors have been connected securely and
there is no poor connection.
I10
I9
NG
Inverter Connector
A092044E02
CONNECT SECURELY
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–383
OK
4
CONFIRM INFORMATION (EXCLUSIVE INFO 4)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(c) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Select DTC P0A94 to display its freeze frame data.
(f) Select the item that has INF code 554, 555, or 556 from
among INFORMATION 1 to 5, and press ENTER.
(g) Read EXCLUSIVE INFO 4.
Result:
Displayed in Exclusive Information 4
Proceed to
-127 to -120, -95 to -88, -63 to -56, -31 to -24, 1 to 8, 33 to 40, 65 to
72, 97 to 104
A
-119 to -112, -87 to -80, -55 to -48, -23 to -16, 9 to 16, 41 to 48, 73 to
80, 105 to 112
B
-111 to -104, -79 to -72, -47 to -40, -15 to -8, 17 to 24, 49 to 56, 81 to
88, 113 to 120
C
-103 to -96, -71 to -64, -39 to -32, -7 to 0, 25 to 32, 57 to 64, 89 to 96,
121 to 127
D
B
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
C
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
D
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE
ASSEMBLY
A
5
INSPECT HYBRID VEHICLE MOTOR ASSEMBLY
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
HV
HV–384
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Hybrid Vehicle Motor:
I14
U
V
W
A092045E03
(d) Disconnect the three-phase alternating current cable for
the hybrid vehicle motor from the inverter.
(e) Using a milliohm meter, measure the resistance between
the three-phase alternating current cable terminals of the
hybrid vehicle motor.
NOTICE:
If the motor temperature is too high, the resistance
varies considerably, which hinders determining
malfunction. Therefore, measure the resistance at a
minimum 8 hours after the vehicle has been
stopped.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition*
U (I14-1) - V (I14-2)
Below 135 mΩ at 20°C
V (I14-2) - W (I14-3)
Below 135 mΩ at 20°C
W (I14-3) - U (I14-1)
Below 135 mΩ at 20°C
*: Apply the formula given below to correct the
resistance.
R20 = Rt / {1 + 0.00393 x (T - 20)}
R20: Resistance converted to 20°C (mΩ)
Rt: Resistance between measured lines (mΩ)
T: Ambient air temperature during measurement (°C)
(f) Calculate the difference between the maximum and
minimum resistance between terminals U - V, V - W, and
W - U.
Standard resistance:
Below 2 mΩ
(g) Using a megohmmeter, measure the insulation
resistance between the three-phase alternating current
cable terminals of the hybrid vehicle motor and the body
ground.
Standard resistance
HV
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
U (I14-1) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
V (I14-2) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
W (I14-3) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
(h) Reconnect the three-phase alternating current cable for
the hybrid vehicle motor.
NG
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE MOTOR
ASSEMBLY
OK
6
INSPECT HYBRID VEHICLE GENERATOR ASSEMBLY
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Check that the service plug grip and inverter cover have
been removed.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Hybrid Vehicle Generator:
I15
V
W
U
A092046E03
HV–385
(b) Disconnect the three-phase alternating current cable for
the hybrid vehicle generator from the inverter.
(c) Using a milliohm meter, measure the resistance between
the three-phase alternating current cable terminals of the
hybrid vehicle generator.
NOTICE:
If the generator temperature is too high, the
resistance varies considerably, which hinders
determining malfunction. Therefore, measure the
resistance at a minimum 8 hours after the vehicle
has been stopped.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition*
U (I15-1) - V (I15-2)
Below 109 mΩ at 20°C
V (I15-2) - W (I15-3)
Below 109 mΩ at 20°C
W (I15-3) - U (I15-1)
Below 109 mΩ at 20°C
*: Apply the formula given below to correct the
resistance.
R20 = Rt / {1 + 0.00393 x (T - 20)}
R20: Resistance converted to 20°C (mΩ)
Rt: Resistance between measured lines (mΩ)
T: Ambient air temperature during measurement (°C)
(d) Calculate the difference between the maximum and
minimum resistance between terminals U - V, V - W, and
W - U.
Standard resistance:
Below 2 mΩ
(e) Using a megohmmeter, measure the insulation
resistance between the three-phase alternating current
cable terminals of the hybrid vehicle generator and the
body ground.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
U (I15-1) - Body ground
10 MΩor higher
V (I15-2) - Body ground
10 MΩor higher
W (I15-3) - Body ground
10 MΩor higher
(f)
Reconnect the three-phase alternating current cable for
the hybrid vehicle generator.
NG
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE GENERATOR
ASSEMBLY
OK
7
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (INVERTER STOP)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Check that the service plug grip and inverter cover have
been removed.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
HV
HV–386
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(d) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(e) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / ACTIVE TEST.
(f) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the
inverter connector while effecting INVERTER STOP.
Standard voltage
I10
GUU GVU GWU MUU MVU MWU
I10
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
MUU (I10-9) - GINV (I10-16)
12 to 16 V
MVU (I10-10) - GINV (I10-16)
12 to 16 V
MWU (I10-11) - GINV (I10-16)
12 to 16 V
GUU (I10-4) - GINV (I10-16)
12 to 16 V
GVU (I10-5) - GINV (I10-16)
12 to 16 V
GWU (I10-6) - GINV (I10-16)
12 to 16 V
(g) Turn the power switch OFF.
GINV
Inverter Connector
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
A093730E07
NG
8
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (INVERTER STOP)
HV
I10
GUU GVU GWU MUU MVU MWU
I10
GINV
Inverter Connector
A093731E05
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Check that the service plug grip and inverter cover have
been removed.
(b) Disconnect the I10 inverter connector.
(c) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(e) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(f) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / ACTIVE TEST.
(g) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the
inverter connector while effecting INVERTER STOP.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
MUU (I10-9) - GINV (I10-16)
14 to 16 V
MVU (I10-10) - GINV (I10-16)
14 to 16 V
MWU (I10-11) - GINV (I10-16)
14 to 16 V
GUU (I10-4) - GINV (I10-16)
14 to 16 V
GVU (I10-5) - GINV (I10-16)
14 to 16 V
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
GWU (I10-6) - GINV (I10-16)
14 to 16 V
(h)
(i)
(j)
(k)
HV–387
Turn the power switch OFF.
Reconnect the inverter connector.
Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
OK
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
HV
HV–388
DTC
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
P0A94557
DC / DC Converter Performance
DESCRIPTION
See the description of the booster converter (see page HV-350).
If the boost converter has a circuit malfunction, internal short, or overheats, the boost converter transmits
that information to the FCV terminal of the HV control ECU via the boost converter fail signal line.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A94
557
Boost converter fail (FCV) signal
detection (circuit malfunction)
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
If the boost converter detects a circuit malfunction, it transmits a boost converter fail signal to the HV
control ECU. Upon receiving this signal, the HV control ECU illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A94 (INF 557):
FCV detection circuit malfunction
Required sensor / components
Boost converter
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
HV
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Boost converter
Circuit malfunction
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Boost converter
DTC P0A94 (INF 557) is not detected
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0A78 (INF 282) (see page HV-244).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–389
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV ECU)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTC listed in the table below is output
DTC No.
INF Code
Detection Item
See Page
P0A94
551 or 552
DC / DC Converter Malfunction
HV-366
YES
GO TO THE PAGE NUMBER SHOWN IN THE
TABLE ABOVE
NO
2
CHECK CONNECTION CONDITION OF INVERTER CONNECTOR (LOOSENESS AND
POOR CONTACT)
I10
I9
Inverter Connector
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
(d) Check the connection condition of the I9 and I10 inverter
connectors.
OK:
Connectors have been connected securely and
there is no poor connection.
(e) Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
(f) Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
CONNECT SECURELY
A092044E02
OK
3
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV ECU)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HV
HV–390
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(c) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(d) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTCs P0A78 (INF 282, 286) and P0A7A (INF 324)
(inverter circuit malfunction) are output
NO
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
YES
4
INSPECT INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY (IGCT VOLTAGE)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(e) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the
inverter connector.
Standard voltage
HV
I9
Inverter Connector
GND1(-)
IGCT (+)
A093729E02
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
IGCT (I9-1) - GND1 (I9-2)
8 V or more
(f) Turn the power switch OFF.
(g) Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
(h) Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A94558
DC / DC Converter Performance
DTC
P0A94559
DC / DC Converter Performance
DTC
P0A94560
DC / DC Converter Performance
HV–391
DESCRIPTION
See the description of the boost converter (see page HV-350).
Upon receiving a boost converter gate shutdown signal from the HV control ECU, the boost converter
forcefully stops the operation of the boost converter by turning OFF the power transistors that are
actuating the boost converter.
The HV control ECU monitors the boost converter gate shutdown signal line and detects a malfunction.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A94
558
GND short in boost converter
gate shutdown (CSDN) signal
circuit
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0A94
559
Open or +B short in boost
converter gate shutdown (CSDN)
signal circuit
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0A94
560
Open in boost converter gate
shutdown (CSDN) signal circuit
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU monitors the boost converter gate shutdown (CSDN) signal line. If the HV control
ECU detects an open or short malfunction of the CSDN signal circuit, the HV control ECU illuminates the
MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A94 (INF 558 / 559 / 560):
Boost converter / Converter gate shutdown signal malfunction
Required sensor / components
Boost converter
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
1 driving cycle
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Boost converter gate shutdown signal circuit
Open or short
HV
HV–392
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Boost converter
DTC P0A94 (INF 558 / 559 / 560) is not detected
WIRING DIAGRAM
(Shielded)
Inverter
29
CSDN I10
W
A
HV Control ECU
9
H16 CSDN
J5
J/C
IK
A092105E06
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HV
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - INVERTER)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–393
(c) Disconnect the H16 HV control ECU connector.
(d) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
H16
CSDN
HV Control ECU Connector
A065745E38
(e) Disconnect the I10 inverter connector.
(f) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(g) Measure the voltage between the terminal of the HV
control ECU connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side:
I10
I10
Inverter Connector
CSDN
A092041E46
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
CSDN (H16-9) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(h) Turn the power switch OFF.
(i) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
CSDN (H16-9) - CSDN (I10-29)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
CSDN (H16-9) or CSDN (I10-29) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(j)
(k)
(l)
(m)
Reconnect the inverter connector.
Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
HV
HV–394
DTC
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
P0A94561
DC / DC Converter Performance
DESCRIPTION
See the description of the boost converter (see page HV-350).
Upon receiving a boost converter gate shutdown signal from the HV control ECU, the boost converter
forcefully stops the operation of the boost converter by turning OFF the power transistors that are
actuating the boost converter.
The HV control ECU monitors the boost converter gate shutdown signal and detects a malfunction.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A94
561
Abnormal boost converter gate
shutdown (CSDN) signal
•
•
Wire harness or connector
HV control ECU
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU monitors the boost converter gate shutdown (CSDN) signal. If the HV control ECU
detects an abnormality in the CSDN signal, it illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
HV
Related DTCs
P0A94 (INF 561):
Boost converter / Converter shutdown signal line malfunction
Required sensor / components
Boost converter
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Actual status of shutdown command signal and its monitoring result
Inconsistent
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Boost converter
DTC P0A94 (INF 561) is not detected
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0A94 (INF 558) (see page HV-390).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–395
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV ECU)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTC P0A94 (INF 561) and other DTCs are output
HINT:
If any other codes besides P0A94 (INF 561) are output,
perform troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
YES
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
NO
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - INVERTER)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Disconnect the H16 HV control ECU connector.
(d) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
H16
CSDN
HV Control ECU Connector
A065745E38
HV
HV–396
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
(e) Disconnect the I10 inverter connector.
(f) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(g) Measure the voltage between the terminal of the HV
control ECU connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side:
I10
I10
Inverter Connector
CSDN
A092041E46
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
CSDN (H16-9) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(h) Turn the power switch OFF.
(i) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
CSDN (H16-9) - CSDN (I10-29)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
CSDN (H16-9) or CSDN (I10-29) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(j)
(k)
(l)
(m)
Reconnect the inverter connector.
Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
HV
OK
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A94583
DC / DC Converter Performance
DTC
P0A94584
DC / DC Converter Performance
HV–397
DESCRIPTION
Output Voltage V
5.0
4.0
3.0
2.0
1.0
0
0 25 50 75 100 125 150
(32) (77)(122)(167)(212)(257)(302)
Temperature °C (°F)
A093728E02
See the description of the boost converter (see page HV-350).
The HV control ECU uses a temperature sensor, which is built into the boost converter, to detect the
temperature of the boost converter.
The boost converter temperature sensor outputs a voltage, which varies between 0 and 5 V in accordance
with the changes in the temperature. The higher the boost converter temperature, the lower the output
voltage. Conversely, the lower the temperature, the higher the output voltage.
The HV control ECU limits the load based on the signals transmitted by the boost converter temperature
sensor, in order to prevent the boost converter from overheating. Furthermore, the HV control ECU
detects a malfunction in the wiring of the boost converter temperature sensor, as well as in the sensor
itself.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A94
583
Open or GND short in boost
converter temperature sensor
circuit
•
•
P0A94
584
+B short in boost converter
temperature sensor circuit
•
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
HV control ECU
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
HV control ECU
HINT:
After confirming DTC P0A94 (INF 583 or 584), confirm CONVERTER TEMP in DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD
/ HV ECU / DATA LIST using the intelligent tester.
Temperature Displayed
Malfunction
-50°C (-58°F)
+B short circuit
205°C (401°F)
Open or GND short circuit
HV
HV–398
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU monitors the boost converter temperature sensor circuit. If the HV control ECU
detects an open or short malfunction of the sensor circuit, the HV control ECU illuminates the MIL and
sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A94 (INF 583 / 584):
Boost converter / Converter temperature sensor malfunction
Required sensor / components
Boost converter
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
1 driving cycle
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Boost converter temperature sensor circuit
Open or short
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Boost converter
DTC P0A94 (INF 583 / 584) is not detected
WIRING DIAGRAM
HV
Inverter
HV Control ECU
(Shielded)
14
CT I10
R
21
H16 CT
32
GCNV I10
G
8
H16 GCNV
J5
J/C
A
IK
A092106E05
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–399
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (CONVERTER TEMP)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DATA LIST.
(e) Read the CONVERTER TEMP value.
Result:
Temperature Displayed
Proceed to
-50°C (-58°F)
A
205°C (401°F)
B
-49°C to 204°C (-57°F to 400°F)
C
HINT:
• If there is a +B short circuit, the intelligent tester
indicates -50°C (-58°F).
• If there is an open or GND short circuit, the intelligent
tester indicates 205°C (401°F).
B
C
Go to step 4
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
A
2
HV
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (CHECK FOR +B SHORT IN WIRE HARNESS)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
HV–400
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
(d) Disconnect the I10 inverter connector.
Wire Harness Side:
I10
CT
I10
Inverter Connector
GCNV
A092041E25
Converter Temperature
Sensor
HV Control ECU
CT
GCNV
HV
A125426E02
(e) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(f) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DATA LIST.
(g) Read the CONVERTER TEMP value.
OK:
205°C (401°F)
(h) Turn the power switch OFF.
(i) Reconnect the inverter connector.
(j) Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
(k) Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
NG
3
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (CHECK FOR +B SHORT IN HYBRID VEHICLE
CONTROL ECU)
(a) Disconnect the H16 HV control ECU connector.
H16
GCNV
CT
HV Control ECU Connector
A065745E39
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Converter Temperature
Sensor
HV Control ECU
CT
GCNV
HV–401
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DATA LIST.
(d) Read the CONVERTER TEMP value on the intelligent
tester.
OK:
205°C (401°F)
(e) Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
NG
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
A126232E01
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - INVERTER)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
(d) Disconnect the H16 HV control ECU connector.
H16
GCNV
CT
HV Control ECU Connector
A065745E39
HV
HV–402
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Wire Harness Side:
(e) Disconnect the I10 inverter connector.
(f) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
I10
Tester Connection
CT
I10
Inverter Connector
GCNV
A092041E25
Specified Condition
CT (H16-21) - CT (I10-14)
Below 1 Ω
GCNV (H16-8) - GCNV (I10-32)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
CT (H16-21) or CT (I10-14) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
GCNV (H16-8) or GCNV (I10-32) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(g)
(h)
(i)
(j)
Reconnect the inverter connector.
Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
5
INSPECT HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU (CT VOLTAGE)
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(b) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the H16
HV control ECU connector.
Standard voltage
HV
H16
CT (+)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
CT (H16-21) - GCNV (H16-8)
2.0 to 4.5 V
NG
GCNV (-)
HV Control ECU Connector
A093719E01
OK
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A94585
HV–403
DC / DC Converter Performance
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0A94 (INF 589) (see page HV-412).
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A94
585
Boost converter voltage (VL)
sensor performance problem
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU monitors the boost converter voltage sensor signal. If the HV control ECU detects an
abnormality in the sensor signal, it illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A94 (INF 585): Boost converter / Voltage (VL) sensor deviation
Required sensor / components
Boost converter, inverter, battery ECU
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
HV
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Boost converter
DTC P0A94 (INF 585) is not detected
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0A94 (INF 589) (see page HV-413).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
HV–404
1
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV ECU)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTC P0A94 (INF 585) and other DTCs are output
HINT:
If any other codes besides P0A94 (INF 585) are output,
perform troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
YES
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
NO
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - INVERTER)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Disconnect the H16 HV control ECU connector.
(d) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
HV
H16
GCNV
VL
HV Control ECU Connector
A065745E40
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Wire Harness Side:
(e) Disconnect the I10 inverter connector.
(f) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(g) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the HV
control ECU connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
I10
Inverter Connector
VL
I10
Front View
HV–405
GCNV
A092041E26
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VL (H16-30) - Body ground
Below 1 V
GCNV (H16-8) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(h) Turn the power switch OFF.
(i) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VL (H16-30) - VL (I10-15)
Below 1 Ω
GCNV (H16-8) - GCNV (I10-32)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VL (H16-30) or VL (I10-15) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
GCNV (H16-8) or GCNV (I10-32) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(j)
(k)
(l)
(m)
Reconnect the inverter connector.
Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
HV
HV–406
DTC
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
P0A94587
DC / DC Converter Performance
DESCRIPTION
See the description of the boost converter (see page HV-350).
The HV control ECU uses two voltage sensors, VL and VB, to detect voltage levels. The VL sensor that
has been built into the boost converter is used to detect the high voltage before it is boosted. The VB
sensor that has been built into the battery ECU is used to detect voltage of the HV battery.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A94
587
Difference between voltages from
HV battery voltage (VB) sensor
and boost converter voltage (VL)
sensor is large
•
•
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
Service plug grip
High voltage fuse
Battery ECU
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU monitors signals of HV battery voltage (VB) and boost converter voltage (VL)
sensors. When a large difference occurs between the voltages from the VB and VL sensors, the HV
control ECU interprets this as a failure of either of the sensors. The HV control ECU then illuminates the
MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
HV
Related DTCs
P0A94 (INF 587):
Voltage (VB or VL) sensor deviation
Required sensor / components
Boost converter, battery ECU
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Difference between the voltages of HV battery and boost converter
voltage sensors
Exceeds the standard level
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Boost converter
Battery ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0A94 (INF 589) (see page HV-413).
DTC P0A94 (INF 587) is not detected
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–407
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV ECU)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
Only DTC P0A94 (INF 587)
A
DTCs P0A94 (INF 587), and P0A1F (INF 129) (HV battery voltage
circuit malfunction)
B
DTCs P0A94 (INF 587), and P0A94 (INF 442) (Abnormal voltage
execution value)
C
DTCs P0A94 (INF 587), and P0A94 (INF 585) (Boost converter
voltage (VL) sensor performance problem)
D
DTCs other than above
E
B
C
GO TO DTC P0A1F-129
Go to step 4
D
GO TO DTC P0A94-585
E
AFTER PERFORMING "CHECK HARNESS
AND CONNECTOR" PROCEDURE, GO TO
RELEVANT DTC CHART
A
2
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV BATTERY)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV BATTERY / DTC INFO / TROUBLE CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTCs are output
HV
HV–408
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
YES
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
NO
3
INSPECT SERVICE PLUG GRIP
A081749E02
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the
service plug grip.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
(d) Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
Go to step 6
OK
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - INVERTER)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Disconnect the H16 HV control ECU connector.
(d) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
HV
H16
GCNV
VL
HV Control ECU Connector
A065745E40
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Wire Harness Side:
(e) Disconnect the I10 inverter connector.
(f) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(g) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the HV
control ECU connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
I10
VL
I10
Inverter Connector
HV–409
GCNV
A092041E27
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VL (H16-30) - Body ground
Below 1 V
GCNV (H16-8) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(h) Turn the power switch OFF.
(i) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VL (H16-30) - VL (I10-15)
Below 1 Ω
GCNV (H16-8) - GCNV (I10-32)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VL (H16-30) or VL (I10-15) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
GCNV (H16-8) or GCNV (I10-32) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(j)
(k)
(l)
(m)
Reconnect the inverter connector.
Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
5
CHECK OUTPUT DTC
(a) Proceed to A if only DTC P0A94 (INF 587) is output as a
result of DTC reading in the "READ OUTPUT DTC"
procedure.
(b) Proceed to B if DTCs P0A94 (INF 587) and P0A94 (INF
442) are output as a result of DTC reading in the "READ
OUTPUT DTC" procedure.
B
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
A
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY AND BATTERY ECU ASSEMBLY
HV
HV–410
6
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT HIGH VOLTAGE FUSE
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Remove the high voltage fuse (see page HB-154).
HINT:
The high voltage fuse is enclosed in the service plug
grip.
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the
high voltage fuse.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
(c) Reinstall the high voltage fuse (see page HB-154).
A057824E02
OK
REPLACE SERVICE PLUG GRIP
HV
NG
REPLACE HIGH VOLTAGE FUSE
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A94588
HV–411
DC / DC Converter Performance
DESCRIPTION
See the description of the boost converter (see page HV-350).
The boost converter switches the power transistors ON and OFF in accordance with the power transistor
actuation signals received from the HV control ECU, in order to change the current that flows into the
reactor.
Also, the boost converter regulates the duration of the switching time through PWM (Pulse Width
Modulation) control, in order to control the boosting voltage.
The HV control ECU monitors the boost converter PWM circuit and detects a malfunction.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A94
588
Abnormality in boost converter
PWM circuit
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU monitors the boost converter PWM circuit. If there is an error in the power transistor
actuation signals which are transmitted to the boost converter, the HV control ECU interprets this as a
malfunction of the boost converter PWM circuit.
The HV control ECU illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A94 (INF 588): Boost converter / Converter PWM malfunction
Required sensor / components
Boost converter
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
1 driving cycle
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Power transistor actuation signal
Abnormal
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Boost converter
DTC P0A94 (INF 588) is not detected
HV
HV–412
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
HV Control ECU
(Shielded)
Inverter
13
CPWM I10
B
10
H16 CPWM
32
GCNV I10
G
8
H16 GCNV
J5
J/C
A
IK
A092106E06
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
HV
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - INVERTER)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Disconnect the H16 HV control ECU connector.
(d) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
H16
GCNV
CPWM
HV Control ECU Connector
A065745E41
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Wire Harness Side:
(e) Disconnect the I10 inverter connector.
(f) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(g) Measure the voltage between the terminal of the HV
control ECU connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
I10
CPWM
I10
Inverter Connector
HV–413
GCNV
A092041E28
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
CPWM (H16-10) - Body ground
Below 1 V
GCNV (H16-8) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(h) Turn the power switch OFF.
(i) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
CPWM (H16-10) - CPWM (I10-13)
Below 1 Ω
GCNV (H16-8) - GCNV (I10-32)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
CPWM (H16-10) or CPWM (I10-13) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
GCNV (H16-8) or GCNV (I10-32) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(j)
(k)
(l)
(m)
Reconnect the inverter connector.
Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
HV
HV–414
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0A94589
DC / DC Converter Performance
DTC
P0A94590
DC / DC Converter Performance
DESCRIPTION
Output
Voltage (V)
5.0
4.0
3.0
2.0
1.0
0
100 200 300 400 500 600 700
High-Voltage (V)
A125422E01
HV
See the description of the boost converter (see page HV-350).
The HV control ECU uses a voltage sensor, which has been built into the boost converter, to detect the
high voltage before it is boosted and for boost control.
The boost converter voltage sensor outputs a voltage that varies between 0 and 5 V in accordance with
the changes in the high voltage. The higher the high voltage, the higher the output voltage, and the lower
the high voltage, the lower the output voltage.
The HV control ECU monitors a signal line of the boost converter voltage sensor and detects a
malfunction.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0A94
589
Open or GND short in boost
converter voltage (VL) sensor
circuit
•
•
•
P0A94
590
+B short in boost converter
voltage (VL) sensor circuit
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
HV control ECU
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
HV control ECU
HINT:
After confirming DTC P0A94 (INF 589 or 590), confirm VL in DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD / HV ECU / DATA
LIST using the intelligent tester.
Voltage Displayed
Malfunction
510 V
+B short circuit
0V
Open or GND short circuit
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU monitors the boost converter voltage (VL) sensor circuit. If the HV control ECU
detects an open or short malfunction of the VL sensor circuit, the HV control ECU illuminates the MIL and
sets a DTC.
HV–415
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0A94 (INF 589 / 590): Boost converter / VL malfunction
Required sensor / components
Boost converter
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
1 driving cycle
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
Boost converter voltage sensor circuit
Short
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
Boost converter
DTC P0A94 (INF 589 / 590) is not detected
WIRING DIAGRAM
Inverter
HV Control ECU
(Shielded)
15
VL I10
Y
32
GCNV I10
G
J5
J/C
30
H16 VL
HV
8
H16 GCNV
A
IK
A092106E07
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
HV–416
1
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (VL)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DATA LIST.
(e) Read the VL value.
Result:
Voltage Displayed
Proceed to
510 V
A
0V
B
1 to 509 V
C
HINT:
• If there is a +B short circuit, the intelligent tester
indicates 510 V.
• If there is an open or GND short circuit, the intelligent
tester indicates 0 V.
B
C
Go to step 4
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
A
2
HV
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (CHECK FOR +B SHORT IN WIRE HARNESS)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–417
(d) Disconnect the I10 inverter connector.
Wire Harness Side:
I10
VL
I10
GCNV
Inverter Connector
A092041E29
Boost Converter
Voltage Sensor
HV Control ECU
VL
GCNV
A125426E03
(e) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(f) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DATA LIST.
(g) Read the VL value.
Standard voltage:
0V
(h) Turn the power switch OFF.
(i) Reconnect the inverter connector.
(j) Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
(k) Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
NG
3
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (CHECK FOR +B SHORT IN HYBRID VEHICLE
CONTROL ECU)
(a) Disconnect the H16 HV control ECU connector.
H16
GCNV
VL
HV Control ECU Connector
A065745E40
HV
HV–418
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Boost Converter
Voltage Sensor
HV Control ECU
VL
GCNV
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DATA LIST.
(d) Read the VL value.
Standard voltage:
0V
(e) Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
NG
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
A126232E02
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - INVERTER)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
(d) Disconnect the H16 HV control ECU connector.
HV
H16
GCNV
VL
HV Control ECU Connector
A065745E40
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Wire Harness Side:
(e) Disconnect the I10 inverter connector.
(f) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
I10
Tester Connection
VL
I10
Inverter Connector
HV–419
GCNV
A092041E29
Specified Condition
VL (H16-30) - VL (I10-15)
Below 1 Ω
GCNV (H16-8) - GCNV (I10-32)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VL (H16-30) or VL (I10-15) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
GCNV (H16-8) or GCNV (I10-32) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(g)
(h)
(i)
(j)
Reconnect the inverter connector.
Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
5
CHECK HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU (VL VOLTAGE)
(a) Turn the power switch ON (READY).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(b) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the H16
HV control ECU connector.
Standard voltage
H16
VL (+)
GCNV (-)
HV Control ECU Connector
A093719E19
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VL (H16-30) - GCNV (H16-8)
1.9 to 3.4 V
NG
OK
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
HV
HV–420
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0AA1231
Hybrid Battery Positive Contactor Circuit Stuck
Closed
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0AE7 (INF 224) (see page HV-444).
Because it might be impossible to shut off the high-voltage system if either of the No. 1 and No. 2 system
main relays becomes stuck, the HV control ECU monitors the two relays and stops the system if
malfunction is found in either relay.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0AA1
231
System main relay terminal of HV
battery positive side stuck closed
•
•
No. 1 system main relay
No. 2 system main relay
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
INSPECT NO. 1 SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
(a) Inspect the No. 1 system main relay (see page HB-124).
HV
NG
OK
REPLACE NO. 2 SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
REPLACE NO. 1 SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0AA1233
HV–421
Hybrid Battery Positive Contactor Circuit Stuck
Closed
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0AE7 (INF 224) (see page HV-444).
Because it might be impossible to shut off the high-voltage system if any one of the No. 1 to No. 3 system
main relays becomes stuck, the HV control ECU monitors the 3 relays and stops the system if malfunction
is found in either relay.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0AA1
233
System main relay terminals of
HV battery positive and negative
sides stuck closed
•
•
•
No. 1 system main relay
No. 2 system main relay
No. 3 system main relay
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
INSPECT NO. 1 SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
(a) Inspect the No. 1 system main relay (see page HB-124).
NG
REPLACE NO. 1 SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
OK
2
INSPECT NO. 2 SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
(a) Inspect the No. 2 system main relay (see page HB-126).
NG
OK
REPLACE NO. 3 SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
REPLACE NO. 2 SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
HV
HV–422
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0AA4232
Hybrid Battery Negative Contactor Circuit
Stuck Closed
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0AE7 (INF 224) (see page HV-444).
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0AA4
232
System main relay terminal of HV
battery negative side stuck closed
•
No. 3 system main relay
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU monitors the No. 3 system main relay, because shutting off the high-voltage system
might be impossible if the relay terminal becomes stuck. If the HV control ECU detects that the relay
terminal has stuck closed, it illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0AA4 (INF 232): SMR circuit / "-" side stuck
Required sensor / components
No. 3 system main relay
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
Immediately
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
HV
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
No. 3 system main relay
DTC P0AA4 (INF 232) is not detected
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
If the information (INF) code is present, replace the No. 3 system main relay.
1
REPLACE NO. 3 SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
(a) Replace the No. 3 system main relay (see page HB124).
NEXT
COMPLETED
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–423
DTC
P0AA6526
Hybrid Battery Voltage System Isolation Fault
DTC
P0AA6611
Hybrid Battery Voltage System Isolation Fault
DTC
P0AA6612
Hybrid Battery Voltage System Isolation Fault
DTC
P0AA6613
Hybrid Battery Voltage System Isolation Fault
DTC
P0AA6614
Hybrid Battery Voltage System Isolation Fault
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0AA6
526*1
Insulation resistance of high
voltage circuit and body is low
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Frame wire
System main relay
System main resistor
HV battery assembly
Electric inverter compressor
Battery ECU
HV transaxle assembly
Inverter with converter
assembly
Main battery cable
No. 2 main battery cable
Battery plug
No. 2 frame wire
Junction block
P0AA6
611*2
Insulation resistance of A/C
compressor motor or A/C inverter
is low
•
•
Electric inverter compressor
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0AA6
612*2
Insulation resistance of HV
battery, battery ECU, system
main relay, or system main
resistor is low
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
HV battery assembly
Battery ECU
System main relay
System main resistor
Main battery cable
No. 2 main battery cable
Battery plug
No. 2 frame wire
Junction block
P0AA6
613*2
Insulation resistance of HV
transaxle or motor and generator
inverters is low
•
•
HV transaxle assembly
Inverter with converter
assembly
P0AA6
614*2
Insulation resistance of motor and
generator inverters, A/C inverter,
system main relay, system main
resistor, or frame wire is low
•
•
•
•
•
Frame wire
System main relay
System main resistor
HV battery assembly
Inverter with converter
assembly
Main battery cable
No. 2 main battery cable
Battery plug
No. 2 frame wire
Junction block
•
•
•
•
•
HV
HV–424
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HINT:
*1: Stored simultaneously when DTC P0AA6 is set.
*2: Stored when a malfunction has been isolated after INF code 526 was set. INF code 611 to 614 are set
next trip.
HV
HV–425
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Outline of High-Voltage Circuit and Areas:
INF Code 526
Vehicle Insulation Resistance Reduction
INF Code 612
INF Code 614
HV Battery Area
High Voltage Direct Current Area
HV Battery
Resistor
SMR1
Frame Wire
INF Code 613
Inverter Assembly
SMR2
MG1
Boost
Converter
Battery ECU
Transaxle Area
Inverter
MG2
SMR3
Service
Plug Grip
HV
A/C
Inverter
A/C
Motor
INF Code 611
A/C Area
A125425E01
HV–426
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV ECU)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
DTC P0AA6
A
DTCs P0AA6 and P0A1D (HV control ECU malfunction)
B
DTCs P0AA6 and P0A1F (Battery ECU malfunction)
C
HV
B
GO TO DTC CHART. FIND DTC P0A1D TO
PROCEED TO ITS TROUBLE SHOOTING
FLOWCHART
C
GO TO DTC CHART. FIND DTC P0A1F TO
PROCEED TO ITS TROUBLESHOOTING
FLOWCHART
A
2
READ OUTPUT INF CODE
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Display the freeze frame data for DTC P0AA6 and check
its information (INF) code.
NOTICE:
If only INF code 526 is present, recheck INF code
after waiting for 30 seconds with the power switch
OFF.
Result:
Display (INF Code Output)
Proceed to
Only 526 (Insulation resistance of high voltage circuit and body is low)
A
526 and 611 (Insulation resistance of A/C area is low)
AC-134
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Display (INF Code Output)
Proceed to
526 and 612 (Insulation resistance of HV battery area is low)
B
526 and 613 (Insulation resistance of transaxle area is low)
C
526 and 614 (Insulation resistance of high voltage direct current area
is low)
D
B
Go to step 5
C
Go to step 18
D
Go to step 19
HV–427
A
3
CHECK ELECTRIC INVERTER COMPRESSOR
Electric Inverter Compressor Connector
C4
A087661E03
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Disconnect the C4 electric inverter compressor
connector.
(d) Using a megohmmeter, measure the insulation
resistance between the high-voltage terminals of the
electric inverter compressor connector and the body
ground.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
C4-1 - Body ground
3.0 MΩ or higher
C4-2 - Body ground
3.0 MΩ or higher
C4-3 - Body ground
3.0 MΩ or higher
NG
REPLACE ELECTRIC INVERTER
COMPRESSOR
OK
4
CHECK INSULATION RESISTANCE (INVERTER, TRANSAXLE AND FRAME WIRE)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Check that the service plug grip has been detached.
HV
HV–428
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
A/C Inverter
Connector
C4
(b) Check that the electric inverter compressor connector
has been disconnected.
(c) Using a megohmmeter, measure the insulation
resistance between the high-voltage terminals of the A/C
inverter connector and the body ground.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
C4-1 - Body ground
2.0 MΩ or higher
C4-2 - Body ground
2.0 MΩ or higher
C4-3 - Body ground
2.0 MΩ or higher
A087662E02
NG
Go to step 15
OK
5
CHECK HV BATTERY AREA
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Check that the service plug grip has been detached. If
not, remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Disconnect the B12 and B13 battery ECU connectors.
HV
B13
B12
Battery ECU Connector
A093736E03
A087663E02
(d) Disconnect the main battery cables from the system
main relays.
(e) Using a megohmmeter, measure the insulation
resistance between the positive terminal on the HV
battery side of the system main relay and the body
ground.
Standard resistance:
10 MΩ or higher
(f) Using a megohmmeter, measure the insulation
resistance between the negative terminal on the HV
battery side of the system main relay and the body
ground.
Standard resistance:
10 MΩ or higher
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
OK
HV–429
REPLACE BATTERY ECU ASSEMBLY
NG
6
CHECK SYSTEM MAIN RELAYS FOR STICKING
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Check that the service plug grip has been detached.
(b) Disconnect all the high-voltage terminals of the system
main relays.
(c) Measure the resistance at the switch side of the system
main relays.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
A087664E02
GO TO "CHECK INSULATION RESISTANCE"
PROCEDURE AFTER REPLACING STUCK
SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
OK
7
CHECK SYSTEM MAIN RELAYS FOR INSULATION
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Check that the service plug grip has been detached.
(b) Check that all the high-voltage terminals of the system
main relays have been disconnected.
(c) Using a megohmmeter, measure the insulation
resistance between the high-voltage terminals of the
system main relays and the body ground.
Standard resistance:
10 MΩ or higher
NG
A087665E01
REPLACE SYSTEM MAIN RELAY WITH
REDUCED INSULATION RESISTANCE
OK
8
CHECK SYSTEM MAIN RESISTOR FOR INSULATION
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Check that the service plug grip has been detached.
HV
HV–430
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
(b) Check that both terminals of the system main resistor
have been disconnected.
(c) Using a megohmmeter, measure the insulation
resistance between the high-voltage terminal of the
system main resistor and the body ground.
Standard resistance:
10 MΩ or higher
NG
REPLACE SYSTEM MAIN RESISTOR
A087666E01
OK
9
INSPECT MAIN BATTERY CABLE
Shielded
A
A093737E01
HV
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves and goggles before performing
the following operation.
(a) Remove the HV battery assembly (see page HB-92).
(b) Remove the battery cover (see page HB-93).
(c) Check if the main battery cable cover is not damaged or
internal electrical leads are not in contact with the battery
case or body.
OK:
Electrical leads are not in contact with the battery
case or body
(d) Remove the terminal (A in the illustration) on the battery
module side of the main battery cable only.
(e) Using a megohmmeter, measure the insulation
resistance between each terminal of the main battery
cable and the shielded ground.
Standard resistance:
10 MΩ or higher
NG
REPLACE MAIN BATTERY CABLE
OK
10
INSPECT NO. 2 MAIN BATTERY CABLE
A
A093738E01
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves and goggles before performing
the following operation.
(a) Following the previous step, check if the No. 2 main
battery cable cover is not damaged or internal electrical
leads are not in contact with the battery case or body.
OK:
Electrical leads are not in contact with the battery
case or body
(b) Remove the terminal (A in illustration) on the battery
module side of the No. 2 main battery cable only.
(c) Using a megohmmeter, measure the insulation
resistance between each terminal of the No. 2 main
battery cable and the shielded ground.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–431
Standard resistance:
10 MΩ or higher
NG
REPLACE NO. 2 MAIN BATTERY CABLE
OK
11
INSPECT BATTERY PLUG
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves and goggles before performing
the following operation.
(a) Following the previous step, disconnect only the
connecting terminal of the battery plug.
NOTICE:
Do not reinstall the service plug grip.
(b) Using a megohmmeter, measure the insulation
resistance between each terminal of the battery plug
wire harness and body ground.
Standard resistance:
10 MΩ or higher
A090474E01
NG
REPLACE BATTERY PLUG
OK
12
INSPECT NO. 2 FRAME WIRE
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves and goggles before performing
the following operation.
(a) Following the previous step, check if the No. 2 frame
wire cover is not damaged or internal electrical leads are
not in contact with the battery case or body.
OK:
Electrical leads are not in contact with the battery
case or body.
(b) Remove all the terminals on the battery module side of
the No. 2 frame wire.
(c) Using a megohmmeter, measure the insulation
resistance between each terminal of the No. 2 frame wire
connector and the battery case.
Standard resistance:
10 MΩor higher
NG
A090471E01
OK
REPLACE NO. 2 FRAME WIRE
HV
HV–432
13
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT JUNCTION BLOCK
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves and goggles before performing
the following operation.
(a) Following the previous step, remove the junction block.
(b) Visually check the junction block for any damage.
OK:
No cracks or damage
NG
REPLACE JUNCTION BLOCK
A090472E01
OK
14
INSPECT HV BATTERY ASSEMBLY
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves and goggles before performing
the following operation.
(a) Following the previous step, measure the insulation
resistance between each terminal (positive and negative
side) of each battery module of the HV battery assembly
and the battery case using a megohmmeter.
Standard resistance:
Some of the battery modules have continuity of
below 10 MΩ
HV
NG
REPLACE BATTERY ECU ASSEMBLY
A090470E01
OK
REPLACE HV SUPPLY BATTERY ASSEMBLY
15
CHECK SYSTEM MAIN RELAYS FOR STICKING
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Check that the service plug grip has been detached.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–433
(b) Disconnect all the high-voltage terminals of the system
main relays.
(c) Measure the resistance at the switch side of the system
main relays.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
A087664E02
GO TO "CHECK INSULATION RESISTANCE"
PROCEDURE AFTER REPLACING STUCK
SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
OK
16
CHECK FRAME WIRE FOR INSULATION
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Check that the service plug grip has been detached.
(b) Disconnect the frame wire from the inverter.
(c) Using a megohmmeter, measure the insulation
resistance between the high-voltage terminals of the
frame wire and the body ground.
Standard resistance:
10 MΩor higher
NG
REPLACE FRAME WIRE
A087667E01
HV
OK
17
CHECK HV TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY FOR INSULATION
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Check that the service plug grip has been detached.
(b) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
HV–434
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
(c) Disconnect the three-phase alternating current cables for
the motor and generator from the inverter.
(d) Using a megohmmeter, measure the insulation
resistance between the 6 terminals of the three-phase
alternating current cables on the transaxle side and the
body ground.
Standard resistance
Hybrid Vehicle Motor:
I14
U
W
V
Hybrid Vehicle Generator:
I15
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
U (I14-1) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
V (I14-2) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
W (I14-3) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
U (I15-1) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
V (I15-2) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
W (I15-3) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
NG
V
W
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE
ASSEMBLY
U
A127509E01
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
18
HV
CHECK HV TRANSAXLE AREA FOR INSULATION
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
(d) Disconnect the three-phase alternating current cables for
the motor and generator from the inverter.
(e) Using a megohmmeter, measure the insulation
resistance between the 6 terminals of the three-phase
alternating current cables on transaxle side and the body
ground.
Standard resistance
Hybrid Vehicle Motor:
U
I14
V
W
Hybrid Vehicle Generator:
W
V
HV–435
I15
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
U (I14-1) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
V (I14-2) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
W (I14-3) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
U (I15-1) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
V (I15-2) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
W (I15-3) - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
OK
U
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
A125413E01
NG
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
19
CHECK HIGH VOLTAGE DIRECT CURRENT AREA FOR INSULATION
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Disconnect the frame wire from the inverter.
(d) Using a megohmmeter, measure the insulation
resistance between the high-voltage terminals of the
frame wire and the body ground.
Standard resistance:
10 MΩ or higher
OK
A087667E01
NG
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
HV
HV–436
20
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK FRAME WIRE FOR INSULATION
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Check that the service plug grip has been detached.
(b) Disconnect the frame wire from the system main relays.
(c) Using a megohmmeter, measure the insulation
resistance between the high-voltage terminals of the
frame wire and the body ground.
Standard resistance:
10 MΩ or higher
NG
REPLACE FRAME WIRE
A087670E01
OK
21
CHECK SYSTEM MAIN RELAYS FOR STICKING
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Check that the service plug grip has been detached.
(b) Disconnect all the high-voltage terminals of the system
main relays.
(c) Measure the resistance at the switch side of the system
main relays.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
HV
NG
A087664E02
GO TO "CHECK INSULATION RESISTANCE"
PROCEDURE AFTER REPLACING STUCK
SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
OK
22
CHECK SYSTEM MAIN RELAYS FOR INSULATION
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Check that the service plug grip has been detached.
(b) Check that all the high-voltage terminals of the system
main relays have been disconnected.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–437
(c) Using a megohmmeter, measure the insulation
resistance between the high-voltage terminals of the
system main relays and the body ground.
Standard resistance:
10 MΩ or higher
NG
REPLACE SYSTEM MAIN RELAY WITH
REDUCED INSULATION RESISTANCE
A087665E01
OK
23
CHECK SYSTEM MAIN RESISTOR FOR INSULATION
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Check that the service plug grip has been detached.
(b) Check that both terminals of the system main resistor
have been disconnected.
(c) Using a megohmmeter, measure the insulation
resistance between the high-voltage terminal of the
system main resistor and the body ground.
Standard resistance:
10 MΩ or higher
NG
REPLACE SYSTEM MAIN RESISTOR
A087666E01
HV
OK
24
INSPECT MAIN BATTERY CABLE
Shielded
A
A093737E01
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves and goggles before performing
the following operation.
(a) Remove the HV battery assembly (see page HB-92).
(b) Remove the battery cover (see page HB-93).
(c) Check if the main battery cable cover is not damaged or
internal electrical leads are not in contact with the battery
case or body.
OK:
Electrical leads are not in contact with the battery
case or body
(d) Remove the terminal (A in the illustration) on the battery
module side of the main battery cable only.
(e) Using a megohmmeter, measure the insulation
resistance between each terminal of the main battery
cable and the shielded ground.
Standard resistance:
10 MΩ or higher
HV–438
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
NG
REPLACE MAIN BATTERY CABLE
OK
25
INSPECT NO. 2 MAIN BATTERY CABLE
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves and goggles before performing
the following operation.
(a) Following the previous step, check if the No. 2 main
battery cable cover is not damaged or internal electrical
leads are not in contact with the battery case or body.
OK:
Electrical leads are not in contact with the battery
case or body
(b) Remove the terminal (A in illustration) on the battery
module side of the No. 2 main battery cable only.
(c) Using a megohmmeter, measure the insulation
resistance between each terminal of the No. 2 main
battery cable and the shielded ground.
Standard resistance:
10 MΩ or higher
A
NG
REPLACE NO. 2 MAIN BATTERY CABLE
A093738E01
OK
HV
26
INSPECT BATTERY PLUG
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves and goggles before performing
the following operation.
(a) Following the previous step, disconnect only the
connecting terminal of the battery plug.
NOTICE:
Do not reinstall the service plug grip.
(b) Using a megohmmeter, measure the insulation
resistance between each terminal of the battery plug
wire harness and the body ground.
Standard resistance:
10 MΩ or higher
A090474E01
NG
REPLACE BATTERY PLUG
OK
27
INSPECT NO. 2 FRAME WIRE
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves and goggles before performing
the following operation.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–439
(a) Following the previous step, check if the No. 2 frame
wire cover is not damaged or internal electrical leads are
not in contact with the battery case or body.
OK:
Electrical leads are not in contact with the battery
case or body.
(b) Remove all the terminals on the battery module side of
the No. 2 frame wire.
(c) Using a megohmmeter, measure the insulation
resistance between each terminal of the No. 2 frame wire
connector and the battery case.
Standard resistance:
10 MΩ or higher
NG
REPLACE NO. 2 FRAME WIRE
A090471E01
OK
28
INSPECT JUNCTION BLOCK
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves and goggles before performing
the following operation.
(a) Following the previous step, remove the junction block.
(b) Visually check the junction block for any damage.
OK:
No cracks or damage
NG
REPLACE JUNCTION BLOCK
HV
A090472E01
OK
29
INSPECT HV BATTERY ASSEMBLY
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves and goggles before performing
the following operation.
(a) Following the previous step, measure the insulation
resistance between each terminal (positive and negative
side) of each battery module of the HV battery assembly
and the battery case using a megohmmeter.
Standard resistance:
Some of the battery modules have continuity of
below 10 MΩ
NG
A090470E01
REPLACE BATTERY ECU ASSEMBLY
HV–440
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
OK
REPLACE HV SUPPLY BATTERY ASSEMBLY
HV
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–441
DTC
P0ADC226
Hybrid Battery Positive Contactor Control Circuit High
DTC
P0ADB227
Hybrid Battery Positive Contactor Control Circuit Low
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0AE7 (INF 224) (see page HV-444).
The HV control ECU monitors the proper operation of the No. 2 system main relay (CON2) to check for a
malfunction.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0ADC
226
Open or +B short in No. 2 system
main relay circuit
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
No. 2 system main relay
HV control ECU
P0ADB
227
GND short in No. 2 system main
relay circuit
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
No. 2 system main relay
HV control ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0AE7 (INF 224) (see page HV-445).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
INSPECT NO. 2 SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
(a) Inspect the No. 2 system main relay (see page HB-126).
NG
REPLACE NO. 2 SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
OK
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - NO. 2
SYSTEM MAIN RELAY)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see pageHB-154 ).
HV
HV–442
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Disconnect the H16 HV control ECU connector.
H16
CON2
HV Control ECU Connector
A065745E43
Wire Harness Side:
No. 2 System Main Relay Connector
S22
CON2
A093716E04
(d) Disconnect the S22 No. 2 system main relay connector.
(e) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with the service plug
grip removed.
(f) Measure the voltage between the terminal of the HV
control ECU connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
CON2 (H16-2) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(g) Turn the power switch OFF.
(h) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
HV
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
CON2 (H16-2) - CON2 (S22-2)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
CON2 (H16-2) or CON2 (S22-2) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(i) Reconnect the No. 2 system main relay connector.
(j) Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
(k) Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
OK
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–443
DTC
P0AE0228
Hybrid Battery Negative Contactor Control Circuit High
DTC
P0ADF229
Hybrid Battery Negative Contactor Control Circuit Low
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0AE7 (INF 224) (see page HV-444).
The HV control ECU monitors the proper operation of the No. 3 system main relay (CON3) to check for a
malfunction.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0AE0
228
Open or +B short in No. 3 system
main relay circuit
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
No. 3 system main relay
HV control ECU
P0ADF
229
GND short in No. 3 system main
relay circuit
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
No. 3 system main relay
HV control ECU
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
DTC P0AE0 (INF 228):
The HV control ECU monitors the proper operation of the No. 3 system main relay (CON3). If the HV
control ECU detects an open or short malfunction of the relay circuit, the HV control ECU illuminates the
MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
Related DTCs
P0AE0 (INF 228): Rationality (cont3 malfunction)
Required sensor / components
No. 3 system main relay
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
TOYOTA's intellectual property
MIL operation
1 driving cycle
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
No. 3 system main relay circuit
Short
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
No. 3 system main relay
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0AE7 (INF 224) (see page HV-445).
DTC P0AE0 (INF 228) is not detected
HV
HV–444
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
INSPECT NO. 3 SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
(a) Inspect the No. 3 system main relay (see page HB-126).
NG
REPLACE NO. 3 SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
OK
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - NO. 3
SYSTEM MAIN RELAY)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Disconnect the H16 HV control ECU connector.
HV
H16
CON3
HV Control ECU Connector
A065745E44
Wire Harness Side:
No. 3 System Main Relay Connector
S22
CON3
A093717E04
(d) Disconnect the S22 No. 3 system main relay connector.
(e) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with the service plug
grip removed.
(f) Measure the voltage between the terminal of the HV
control ECU connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
CON3 (H16-3) - Body ground
Below 1 V
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–445
(g) Turn the power switch OFF.
(h) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
CON3 (H16-3) - CON3 (S22-3)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Specified Connection
Specified Condition
CON3 (H16-3) or CON3 (S22-3) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(i) Reconnect the No. 3 system main relay connector.
(j) Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
(k) Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
HV
HV–446
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0AE7224
Hybrid Battery Precharge Contactor Control
Circuit High
DTC
P0AE6225
Hybrid Battery Precharge Contactor Control
Circuit Low
DESCRIPTION
SMR2
SMR1 Resistor
Service Plug Grip
SMR3
A093714E01
HV
The SMRs (System Main Relays) connect and disconnect the high-voltage power supply circuit in
accordance with requests from the HV control ECU. To ensure a reliable operation, they consists of a total
of 3 relays (1 for the negative side and 2 for the positive side).
To connect, SMR1 and SMR3 turn ON initially. Then, SMR2 turns ON and SMR1 turns OFF. This process
protects the circuit from the high-voltage surge current by allowing the limit current to flow via the resistor.
To disconnect, SMR2 and SMR3 turn OFF in that order. The HV control ECU checks that the relays have
turned OFF properly.
The HV control ECU monitors the proper operation of the SMRs (CON1, CON2 and CON3) to check for a
malfunction.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0AE7
224
Open or +B short in No. 1 system
main relay circuit
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
No. 1 system main relay
HV control ECU
P0AE6
225
GND short in No. 1 system main
relay circuit
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
No. 1 system main relay
HV control ECU
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–447
WIRING DIAGRAM
HV Control ECU
HV Battery Assembly
No. 2 System Main Relay
(+)
2
S22
G
1
IC1
G
2
H16 CON2
1
S22
R
2
IC1
R
1
H16 CON1
22
IC1
Y
3
H16 CON3
System Main
Resistor
Service
Plug
Grip
No. 1 System Main Relay
(-)
3
S22
No. 3 System Main Relay
Y
A092107E04
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
INSPECT NO. 1 SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
(a) Inspect the No. 1 system main relay (see page HB-124).
NG
OK
REPLACE NO. 1 SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
HV
HV–448
2
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - NO. 1
SYSTEM MAIN RELAY)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Disconnect the H16 HV control ECU connector.
H16
CON1
HV Control ECU Connector
A065745E42
Wire Harness Side:
No. 1 System Main Relay Connector
S22
HV
CON1
A093715E04
(d) Disconnect the S22 No. 1 system main relay connector.
(e) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with the service plug
grip removed.
(f) Measure the voltage between the terminal of the HV
control ECU connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
CON1 (H16-1) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(g) Turn the power switch OFF.
(h) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
CON1 (H16-1) - CON1 (S22-1)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
CON1 (H16-1) or CON1 (S22-1) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(i) Reconnect the No. 1 system main relay connector.
(j) Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
(k) Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–449
OK
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
HV
HV–450
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0AEE276
Motor Inverter Temperature Sensor "A" Circuit
Range / Performance
DTC
P0AEE277
Motor Inverter Temperature Sensor "A" Circuit
Range / Performance
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0AEF (INF 275) (see page HV-453).
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0AEE
276
Sudden change in motor inverter
temperature sensor output
•
•
•
•
•
•
P0AEE
277
Motor inverter temperature
sensor output deviation
•
•
•
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter cooling system
Water pump with motor
assembly
Cooling fan motor
No. 2 cooling fan motor
Inverter with converter
assembly
Wire harness or connector
Inverter cooling system
Water pump with motor
assembly
Cooling fan motor
No. 2 cooling fan motor
Inverter with converter
assembly
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0AEF (INF 275) (see page HV-453).
HV
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
CHECK QUANTITY OF HV COOLANT
(a) Check that there is a sufficient amount of coolant for the
inverter.
OK:
There is a sufficient amount of coolant for the
inverter
NG
OK
ADD HV COOLANT
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
2
HV–451
CHECK COOLANT HOSE
(a) Check that the hoses of the cooling system are not bent
or clogged (refer to the cooling system [see page HV453]).
OK:
The hoses of the cooling system are not bent or
clogged
NG
CORRECT TO NORMAL CONDITION
OK
3
CHECK CONNECTION CONDITION OF WATER PUMP CONNECTOR (LOOSENESS AND
POOR CONTACT)
(a) Check the connection condition of the water pump
connector.
OK:
Connector has been connected securely and there
is no poor connection.
NG
CONNECT SECURELY
A090415E02
OK
4
CHECK WATER PUMP WITH MOTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Check the operation of the water pump.
OK:
Coolant is sloshing in the reservoir tank
NG
OK
REPLACE WATER PUMP WITH MOTOR
ASSEMBLY
HV
HV–452
5
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK CONNECTION CONDITION OF COOLING FAN MOTOR CONNECTOR
(LOOSENESS AND POOR CONTACT)
(a) Check the connection condition of the cooling fan motor
connectors.
OK:
Connectors have been connected securely and
there is no poor connection.
NG
CONNECT SECURELY
A090546E01
OK
6
INSPECT COOLING FAN MOTOR
(a) Inspect the cooling fan motor (see page CO-5).
NG
REPLACE COOLING FAN MOTOR AND ADD
ENGINE COOLANT
OK
7
INSPECT NO. 2 COOLING FAN MOTOR
(a) Inspect the No. 2 cooling fan motor (see page CO-5).
HV
NG
REPLACE NO. 2 COOLING FAN MOTOR AND
ADD ENGINE COOLANT
OK
8
CHECK CONNECTION CONDITION OF HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU CONNECTOR
(LOOSENESS AND POOR CONTACT)
(a) Check the connection condition of all the connectors at
the HV control ECU.
OK:
Connectors have been connected securely and
there is no poor connection.
NG
HV Control ECU Connector
A093719E09
OK
CONNECT SECURELY
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
9
HV–453
CHECK CONNECTION CONDITION OF INVERTER CONNECTOR (LOOSENESS AND
POOR CONTACT)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
(d) Check the connection condition of the I9 and I10 inverter
connectors.
OK:
Connectors have been connected securely and
there is no poor connection.
I10
I9
NG
CONNECT SECURELY
Inverter Connector
A092044E05
OK
10
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - INVERTER)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Check that the service plug grip and inverter cover have
been removed.
(b) Disconnect the H15 HV control ECU connector.
H15
GINV
MIVT
HV Control ECU Connector
A065744E29
HV
HV–454
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Wire Harness Side:
I10
I9
GINV
I10
Inverter Connector
MIVT
A092063E05
(c) Disconnect the I9 and I10 inverter connectors.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(e) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the HV
control ECU connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
MIVT (H15-19) - Body ground
Below 1 V
GINV (H15-23) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(f) Turn the power switch OFF.
(g) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
MIVT (H15-19) - MIVT (I10-26)
Below 1 Ω
GINV (H15-23) - GINV (I10-16)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
MIVT (H15-19) or MIVT (I10-26) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
GINV (H15-23) or GINV (I10-16) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(h)
(i)
(j)
(k)
HV
Reconnect the inverter connectors.
Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
HV–455
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P0AEF275
Drive Motor Inverter Temperature Sensor "A"
Circuit Low
DTC
P0AF0274
Drive Motor Inverter Temperature Sensor "A"
Circuit High
DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU uses a temperature sensor, which is built into the inverter, to detect the temperature
of the motor inverter. The same cooling system that is routed to the MG1 and MG2 cools the inverter. This
cooling system is independent from the engine cooling system.
The characteristic of the motor inverter temperature sensor is the same as the boost converter
temperature sensor (see page HV-395).
The HV control ECU limits the load based on the signals transmitted by the motor inverter temperature
sensor, in order to check the effectiveness of the inverter cooling system and prevent the inverter from
overheating. Furthermore, the HV control ECU detects a malfunction in the wiring of the motor inverter
temperature sensor, as well as in the sensor itself.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P0AEF
275
Open or GND short in motor
inverter temperature sensor
circuit
•
•
P0AF0
274
+B short in motor inverter
temperature sensor circuit
•
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
HV control ECU
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
HV control ECU
HINT:
After confirming DTC P0AEF (INF 275) or P0AF0 (INF 274), confirm MG2 INVERT TEMP in DIAGNOSIS
/ OBD/MOBD / HV ECU / DATA LIST using the intelligent tester.
Temperature Displayed
Malfunction
-50°C (-58°F)
+B short circuit
205°C (401°F)
Open or GND short circuit
HV
WIRING DIAGRAM
Inverter
HV Control ECU
(Shielded)
26
MIVT I10
L
19
H15 MIVT
16
GINV I10
Y
23
H15 GINV
J5
J/C
A
IK
A092106E08
HV–456
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (MG2 INVERT TEMP)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DATA LIST.
(e) Read the MG2 INVERT TEMP value.
Result:
Temperature Displayed
Proceed to
-50°C (-58°F)
A
205°C (401°F)
B
-49°C to 204°C (-57°F to 400°F)
C
HINT:
• If there is a +B short circuit, the intelligent tester
indicates -50°C (-58°F).
• If there is an open or GND short circuit, the intelligent
tester indicates 205°C (401°F).
HV
B
C
Go to step 4
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
A
2
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (CHECK FOR +B SHORT IN WIRE HARNESS)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–457
(d) Disconnect the I10 inverter connector.
Wire Harness Side:
I10
GINV
I10
Inverter Connector
MIVT
A092041E30
Motor Inverter
Temperature Sensor
HV Control ECU
MIVT
GINV
A125426E04
(e) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(f) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DATA LIST.
(g) Read the MG2 INVERT TEMP value.
OK:
205°C (401°F)
(h) Turn the power switch OFF.
(i) Reconnect the inverter connector.
(j) Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
(k) Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
NG
3
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (CHECK FOR +B SHORT IN HYBRID VEHICLE
CONTROL ECU)
(a) Disconnect the H15 HV control ECU connector.
H15
GINV
MIVT
HV Control ECU Connector
A065744E29
HV
HV–458
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Motor Inverter
Temperature Sensor
HV Control ECU
MIVT
GINV
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DATA LIST.
(d) Read the MG2 INVERT TEMP value.
OK:
205°C (401°F)
(e) Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
NG
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
A126232E03
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - INVERTER)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
(d) Disconnect the H15 HV control ECU connector.
HV
H15
GINV
MIVT
HV Control ECU Connector
A065744E29
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–459
(e) Disconnect the I10 inverter connector.
(f) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Wire Harness Side:
I10
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
MIVT (H15-19) - MIVT (I10-26)
Below 1 Ω
GINV (H15-23) - GINV (I10-16)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
GINV
I10
Inverter Connector
MIVT
A092041E30
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
MIVT (H15-19) or MIVT (I10-26) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
GINV (H15-23) or GINV (I10-16) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(g)
(h)
(i)
(j)
Reconnect the inverter connector.
Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
5
INSPECT HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU (MIVT VOLTAGE)
H15
GINV (-)
MIVT (+)
HV Control ECU Connector
A093719E20
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(b) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the H15
HV control ECU connector.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
MIVT (H15-19) - GINV (H15-23)
2.0 to 4.5 V
NG
OK
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
HV
HV–460
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P2120-111
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "D"
Circuit
DTC
P2121-106
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "D"
Circuit Range / Performance
DTC
P2121-114
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "D"
Circuit Range / Performance
DTC
P2125-112
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "E"
Circuit
DTC
P2126-109
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "E"
Circuit Range / Performance
DTC
P2138-110
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "D" /
"E" Voltage Correlation
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P2122 (INF 104) (see page HV-460).
HV
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P2120
111
Accelerator pedal position main
sensor value does not change
while its sub sensor value
changes
•
Accelerator pedal rod
P2121
106
Internal error of accelerator pedal
position main sensor
•
Accelerator pedal rod
P2121
114
Accelerator pedal not smoothly
returning to its original position
•
Accelerator pedal rod
P2125
112
Accelerator pedal position sub
sensor value does not change
while its main sensor value
changes
•
Accelerator pedal rod
P2126
109
Internal error of accelerator pedal
position sub sensor
•
Accelerator pedal rod
P2138
110
Difference between main sensor
value and sub sensor value is
large
•
Accelerator pedal rod
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
If any of the above information (INF) codes are present, replace the Accelerator pedal rod.
1
REPLACE ACCELERATOR PEDAL ROD
(a) Replace the Accelerator pedal rod (see page HV-567).
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–461
NEXT
COMPLETED
HV
HV–462
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P2122-104
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "D"
Circuit Low Input
DTC
P2123-105
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "D"
Circuit High Input
DTC
P2127-107
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "E"
Circuit Low Input
DTC
P2128-108
Throttle / Pedal Position Sensor / Switch "E"
Circuit High Input
DESCRIPTION
HV
HINT:
• This is the repair procedure for the accelerator pedal position sensor.
• This electrical throttle system does not use a throttle cable.
• This accelerator pedal position sensor is a non-contact type.
The accelerator pedal position sensor is mounted on the accelerator pedal to detect how much it is
depressed. It has 2 sensor terminals (VPA and VPA2) to detect the accelerator pedal position and a
malfunction of the accelerator pedal position sensor itself. Since this sensor is electronically controlled
with hall elements, accurate control and reliability can be obtained.
In the accelerator pedal position sensor, the voltage applied to terminals VPA and VPA2 of the HV control
ECU changes between 0 V and 5 V in proportion to the degree of depressing the accelerator pedal. The
VPA is a signal to indicate the actual accelerator pedal position angle which is used for the HV system
control, and the VPA2 is a signal to indicate the actual accelerator pedal position angle which is used for
detecting a malfunction of the sensor itself (terminal VPA).
The HV control ECU judges how much the accelerator pedal is being depressed from the VPA and VPA2
signals, and controls the HV system based on the signals.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–463
Sensor Voltage (V)
5
Hall Element
Magnet
4
VPA
3.2
EPA
5V
VPA
1.6
VCPA
0.8
VPA2
EPA2
5V
VCP2
Full-Close
Full-Open
Accelerator Pedal Position
Magnet
Accelerator Pedal
Position Sensor
VPA2
HV Control ECU
HV
A019803E25
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P2122
104
Open or GND short in accelerator
pedal position main sensor circuit
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Accelerator pedal rod
HV control ECU
P2123
105
+B short in accelerator pedal
position main sensor circuit
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Accelerator pedal rod
HV control ECU
P2127
107
Open or GND short in accelerator
pedal position sub sensor circuit
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Accelerator pedal rod
HV control ECU
P2128
108
+B short in accelerator pedal
position sub sensor circuit
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Accelerator pedal rod
HV control ECU
HV–464
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
A13
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor
VPA
EPA
VCPA
VPA2
EP2
VCP2
(Shielded)
HV Control ECU
6
L
26 VPA1
H16
5
B
27
H16
4
Y
EP1
25
VCP1
H16
3
W
34 VPA2
H16
2
R
35
H16
1
EP2
33
VCP2
H16
G
J5
J/C
A
IK
A092108E02
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (ACCEL POS #1 AND #2)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
HV
Depressed
Released
FI07052E10
NG
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DATA LIST.
(e) Read the ACCEL POS #1 and #2 values on the
intelligent tester with the engine stopped.
OK:
Changes with accelerator pedal pressure
OK
Go to step 5
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
2
HV–465
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION SENSOR)
(a) Disconnect the H16 HV control ECU connector.
H16
VPA1
EP1
VCP1
EP2
VCP2
VPA2
HV Control ECU Connector
A065745E48
Wire Harness Side:
Accelerator Pedal Position Sensor Connector
A13
(b) Disconnect the A13 accelerator pedal position sensor
connector.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the HV
control ECU connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
VCP2
EP2
VPA2
VCPA
EPA
VPA
Specified Condition
VPA1 (H16-26) - Body ground
Below 1 V
VCP1 (H16-25) - Body ground
Below 1 V
A092050E02
EP1 (H16-27) - Body ground
Below 1 V
VPA2 (H16-34) - Body ground
Below 1 V
VCP2 (H16-33) - Body ground
Below 1 V
EP2 (H16-35) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(e) Turn the power switch OFF.
(f) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VPA1 (H16-26) - VPA (A13-6)
Below 1 Ω
VCP1 (H16-25) - VCPA (A13-4)
Below 1 Ω
EP1 (H16-27) - EPA (A13-5)
Below 1 Ω
VPA2 (H16-34) - VPA2 (A13-3)
Below 1 Ω
VCP2 (H16-33) - VCP2 (A13-1)
Below 1 Ω
EP2 (H16-35) - EP2 (A13-2)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VPA1 (H16-26) or VPA (A13-6) - Body
ground
10 kΩor higher
VCP1 (H16-25) or VCPA (A13-4) Body ground
10 kΩor higher
EP1 (H16-27) or EPA (A13-5) - Body
ground
10 kΩor higher
VPA2 (H16-34) or VPA2 (A13-3) Body ground
10 kΩor higher
VCP2 (H16-33) or VCP2 (A13-1) Body ground
10 kΩor higher
HV
HV–466
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
EP2 (H16-35) or EP2 (A13-2) - Body
ground
10 kΩor higher
(g) Reconnect the accelerator pedal position sensor
connector.
(h) Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
3
INSPECT HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU (VCP1 OR VCP2 VOLTAGE)
(a) Disconnect the A13 accelerator pedal position sensor
connector.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Accelerator Pedal
Position Sensor
Connector
A092051E01
EP1 H16
(c) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the HV
control ECU connector.
Standard voltage
VCP1
HV
VCP2
EP2
HV Control ECU Connector
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VCP1 (H16-25) - EP1 (H16-27)
4.5 to 5.5 V
VCP2 (H16-33) - EP2 (H16-35)
4.5 to 5.5 V
(d) Reconnect the accelerator pedal position sensor
connector.
A093719E14
NG
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
OK
4
REPLACE ACCELERATOR PEDAL ROD
(a) Replace the Accelerator pedal rod (see page HV-567).
GO
5
CHECK IF DTC OUTPUT RECURS (DTC P2122, P2123, P2127 OR P2128)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Perform a simulation test.
(f) Read DTCs.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–467
Result:
DTC P2122, P2123, P2127 or P2128 is not output
again
YES
SYSTEM IS OK
NO
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
HV
HV–468
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P3000-123 HV Battery Malfunction
DTC
P3000-125 HV Battery Malfunction
DTC
P3000-603 HV Battery Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU gives warning to the driver and performs the fail-safe control, according to the
abnormal signal received from the battery ECU.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P3000
123
Abnormal signal input from
battery ECU (HV battery system
malfunction)
•
•
HV battery system
Battery ECU
P3000
125
Abnormal signal input from
battery ECU (High voltage fuse
blown out)
•
•
HV battery system
Battery ECU
P3000
603
Abnormal signal input from
battery ECU (HV battery cooling
system malfunction)
•
•
HV battery system
Battery ECU
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After repairing the malfunction, restart the system (to turn the READY light ON) and recheck the DTCs.
1
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV BATTERY)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV BATTERY / DTC INFO / TROUBLE CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTCs are output
HV
YES
NO
REPLACE BATTERY ECU ASSEMBLY
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
HV–469
P3000-388 HV Battery Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
Based on the malfunction signal received from the battery ECU, the system alerts the driver and effects
fail-safe control.
This DTC is output when the SOC (state of charge) of the HV battery decreases as a result of leaving the
vehicle in the N position, running out of fuel, or malfunction in the HV control system.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P3000
388
Abnormal signal input from
battery ECU (discharge inhibition
control malfunction)
•
•
•
HV control system
Fuel shortage
HV battery assembly
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV ECU)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTC P3000 (INF 388) and other DTCs are output
HINT:
If any other codes besides P3000 (INF 388) are output,
perform troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
YES
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
NO
2
CHECK AMOUNT OF GASOLINE
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Check the amount of gasoline with the fuel gauge in the
meter.
OK:
Appropriate amount of gasoline
NG
REFUEL GASOLINE
OK
3
CHECK IF ENGINE STARTS
(a) Turn the power switch ON (READY).
(b) Check if the engine starts.
OK:
The engine starts
NO
REPLACE HV SUPPLY BATTERY ASSEMBLY
HV
HV–470
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
YES
LEAVE VEHICLE IN P POSITION, AND CHARGE HV BATTERY IN IDLE STATUS UNTIL IDLING
STOPS
HV
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
HV–471
P3000-389 HV Battery Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
Based on the malfunction signal received from the battery ECU, the system alerts the driver and effects
fail-safe control.
This DTC is output if the HV battery is depleted or the HV control system has malfunction.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P3000
389
Abnormal signal input from
battery ECU (drop of high
voltage)
•
•
HV control system
HV battery assembly
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV ECU)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTC P3000 (INF 389) and other DTCs are output
HINT:
If any other codes besides P3000 (INF 389) are output,
perform troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
YES
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
HV
NO
2
CHECK IF ENGINE STARTS
(a) Turn the power switch ON (READY).
(b) Check if the engine starts.
OK:
The engine starts
NG
REPLACE HV SUPPLY BATTERY ASSEMBLY
OK
LEAVE VEHICLE IN P POSITION, AND CHARGE HV BATTERY IN IDLE STATUS UNTIL IDLING
STOPS
HV–472
DTC
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
P3004-131 Power Cable Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P3004
131
High voltage fuse has blown out,
service plug grip is disconnected
or limiter resistance is cut off
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
HV battery system
System main resistor
No. 1 system main relay
No. 2 system main relay
No. 3 system main relay
Main battery cable
No. 2 main battery cable
Frame wire
Inverter with converter
assembly
HV control ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0A78 (INF 266) (see page HV-223).
HV Battery Assembly
HV Control ECU
No. 2 System Main Relay
(+)
2
S22
G
1
IC1
G
2
H16 CON2
1
S22
R
2
IC1
R
1
H16 CON1
22
IC1
Y
3
H16 CON3
System Main
Resistor
HV
Service
Plug
Grip
No. 1 System Main Relay
(-)
No. 3 System Main Relay
3
S22
Y
A092107E03
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–473
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV BATTERY)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV BATTERY / DTC INFO / TROUBLE CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTC P0A95 is output
YES
GO TO DTC P0A95
NO
2
INSPECT SYSTEM MAIN RESISTOR
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Remove the system main resistor (see page HB-136).
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals.
Standard resistance:
18 to 22 Ω
(c) Reinstall the system main resistor (see page HB-136).
NG
REPLACE SYSTEM MAIN RESISTOR
A090485E01
OK
3
INSPECT NO. 1 SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
(a) Inspect the No. 1 system main relay (see page HB-124).
NG
REPLACE NO. 1 SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
OK
4
INSPECT NO. 2 SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
(a) Inspect the No. 2 system main relay (see page HB-126).
NG
OK
REPLACE NO. 2 SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
HV
HV–474
5
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT NO. 3 SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
(a) Inspect the No. 3 system main relay (see page HB-126).
NG
REPLACE NO. 3 SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
OK
6
INSPECT MAIN BATTERY CABLE
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves and goggles before performing
the following operation.
(a) Remove the HV battery assembly (see page HB-92).
(b) Remove the main battery cable (see page HB-103).
(c) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the
main battery cable.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE MAIN BATTERY CABLE
A090469E01
OK
7
HV
INSPECT MAIN BATTERY CABLE
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves and goggles before performing
the following operation.
(a) Check the cover and terminals of the main battery cable
for any abnormality.
OK:
No abnormality is found on the cover and
terminals.
(b) Check the terminals of the HV battery and the system
main relay, which are to be connected to the main cable,
for any abnormality.
OK:
No abnormality is found on the terminals of the HV
battery and system main relay.
NG
OK
REPLACE MAIN BATTERY CABLE. IF
NECESSARY, REPLACE HV BATTERY OR
SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
8
HV–475
INSPECT NO. 2 MAIN BATTERY CABLE
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves and goggles before performing
the following operation.
(a) Remove the No. 2 main battery cable with the HV battery
assembly removed (see page HB-103).
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the No.
2 main battery cable.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE NO. 2 MAIN BATTERY CABLE
A090468E01
OK
9
INSPECT NO. 2 MAIN BATTERY CABLE
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves and goggles before performing
the following operation.
(a) Check the cover and terminals of the No. 2 main battery
cable for any abnormality.
OK:
No abnormality is found on the cover and
terminals.
(b) Check the terminals of the HV battery and the system
main relay, which are to be connected to the No. 2 main
battery cable, for any abnormality.
OK:
No abnormality is found on the terminals of the HV
battery and system main relay.
NG
REPLACE NO. 2 MAIN BATTERY CABLE. IF
NECESSARY, REPLACE HV BATTERY OR
SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
OK
10
INSPECT FRAME WIRE
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
HV
HV–476
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
(a) Disconnect the frame wire from the inverter with
converter.
A
B
A087667E02
(b) Check that the frame wire has been disconnected from
the system main relay.
(c) Using a megohmmeter, measure the insulation
resistance between the high-voltage terminals of the
frame wire and body ground.
Standard resistance
D
C
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
B - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
A093739E01
(d) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the
frame wire.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A-C
Below 1 Ω
B-D
Below 1 Ω
(e) Reinstall the HV battery assembly (see page HB-96).
(f) Reconnect the frame wire.
HV
NG
REPLACE FRAME WIRE
OK
11
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - INVERTER)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–477
(d) Disconnect the H15 HV control ECU connector.
H15
GINV
VH
HV Control ECU Connector
A065744E40
(e) Disconnect the I10 inverter connector.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Wire Harness Side:
I10
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VH (H15-26) - VH (I10-12)
Below 1 Ω
GINV (H15-23) - GINV (I10-16)
Below 1 Ω
(f) Turn the power switch OFF.
(g) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for short)
VH
GINV
I10
Inverter Connector
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VH (H15-26) or VH (I10-12) - Body
ground
10 MΩ or higher
GINV (H15-23) or GINV (I10-16) Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
A092041E32
(h)
(i)
(j)
(k)
Reconnect the inverter connector.
Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
12
INSPECT HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU (HV VOLTAGE)
(a) Turn the power switch ON (READY).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(b) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the H15
HV control ECU connector.
Standard voltage
H15
GINV (-)
VH (+)
HV Control ECU Connector
A093719E15
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VH (H15-26) - GINV (H15-23)
0.3 to 0.7 V
NG
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
HV
HV–478
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
OK
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
HV
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
HV–479
P3004-132 Power Cable Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P3004
132
Inverter voltage sensor
malfunction, or limiter resistance
increases
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
HV control system
System main resistor
No. 1 system main relay
No. 3 system main relay
Main battery cable
No. 2 main battery cable
Frame wire
Inverter with converter
assembly
HV control ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P3004 (INF 131) (see page HV-470).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV ECU)
HV
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DTC INFO / CURRENT CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTC P3004 (INF 132) and other DTCs are output
HINT:
If any other codes besides P3004 (INF 132) are output,
perform troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
YES
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
NO
2
INSPECT SYSTEM MAIN RESISTOR
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves and goggles before performing
the following operation.
HV–480
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
(a) Remove the system main resistor (see page HB-136).
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals.
Standard resistance:
18 to 22 Ω
(c) Reinstall the system main resistor (see page HB-136).
NG
REPLACE SYSTEM MAIN RESISTOR
A090485E01
OK
3
INSPECT NO. 1 SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
(a) Inspect the No. 1 system main relay (see page HB-124).
NG
REPLACE NO. 1 SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
OK
4
INSPECT NO. 3 SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
(a) Inspect the No. 3 system main relay (see page HB-126).
NG
REPLACE NO. 3 SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
OK
HV
5
INSPECT MAIN BATTERY CABLE
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves and goggles before performing
the following operation.
(a) Remove the HV battery assembly (see page HB-92).
(b) Remove the main battery cable (see page HB-103).
(c) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the
main battery cable.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE MAIN BATTERY CABLE
A090469E01
OK
6
INSPECT MAIN BATTERY CABLE
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves and goggles before performing
the following operation.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–481
(a) Check the cover and terminals of the main battery cable
for any abnormality.
OK:
No abnormality is found on the cover and
terminals.
(b) Check the terminals of the HV battery and the system
main relay, which are to be connected to the main cable,
for any abnormality.
OK:
No abnormality is found on the terminals of the HV
battery and system main relay.
NG
REPLACE MAIN BATTERY CABLE. IF
NECESSARY, REPLACE HV BATTERY OR
SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
OK
7
INSPECT NO. 2 MAIN BATTERY CABLE
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves and goggles before performing
the following operation.
(a) Remove the No. 2 main battery cable with the HV battery
assembly removed (see page HB-103).
(b) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the No.
2 main battery cable.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE NO. 2 MAIN BATTERY CABLE
A090468E01
OK
8
INSPECT NO. 2 MAIN BATTERY CABLE
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves and goggles before performing
the following operation.
(a) Check the cover and terminals of the No. 2 main battery
cable for any abnormality.
OK:
No abnormality is found on the cover and
terminals.
(b) Check the terminals of the HV battery and the system
main relay, which are to be connected to the No. 2 main
battery cable, for any abnormality.
OK:
No abnormality is found on the terminals of the HV
battery and system main relay.
HV
HV–482
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
NG
REPLACE NO. 2 MAIN BATTERY CABLE. IF
NECESSARY, REPLACE HV BATTERY OR
SYSTEM MAIN RELAY
OK
9
INSPECT FRAME WIRE
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Disconnect the frame wire from the inverter with
converter.
A
B
A087667E02
(b) Check that the frame wire has been disconnected from
the system main relay.
(c) Using a megohmmeter, measure the insulation
resistance between the high-voltage terminals of the
frame wire and body ground.
Standard resistance
HV
D
C
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
B - Body ground
10 MΩ or higher
A093739E01
(d) Measure the resistance between the terminals of the
frame wire.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A-C
Below 1 Ω
B-D
Below 1 Ω
(e) Reinstall the HV battery assembly (see page HB-96).
(f) Reconnect the frame wire.
NG
REPLACE FRAME WIRE
OK
10
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - INVERTER)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–483
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
(d) Disconnect the H15 HV control ECU connector.
H15
VH
GINV
HV Control ECU Connector
A065744E40
(e) Disconnect the I10 inverter connector.
(f) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(g) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the HV
control ECU connector and body ground.
Standard voltage (Check for open)
Wire Harness Side:
I10
VH
GINV
I10
Inverter Connector
A092041E32
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VH (H15-26) - Body ground
Below 1 V
GINV (H15-23) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(h) Turn the power switch OFF.
(i) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VH (H15-26) or VH (I10-12) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
GINV (H15-23) or GINV (I10-16) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(j)
(k)
(l)
(m)
Reconnect the inverter connector.
Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
11
CHECK HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU (VH VOLTAGE)
(a) Turn the power switch ON (READY).
HV
HV–484
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(b) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the H15
HV control ECU connector.
Standard voltage
H15
GINV (-)
VH (+)
HV Control ECU Connector
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
VH (H15-26) - GINV (H15-23)
1.6 to 3.8 V
NG
A093719E12
OK
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
HV
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
HV–485
P3004-133 Power Cable Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU gives warning to the driver and performs the fail-safe control, according to the
abnormal signal received from the battery ECU.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P3004
133
Abnormal signal input from
battery ECU
•
•
HV battery system
Battery ECU
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ OUTPUT DTC (HV BATTERY)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV BATTERY / DTC INFO / TROUBLE CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTCs are output
YES
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
NO
REPLACE BATTERY ECU ASSEMBLY
HV
HV–486
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P3102-524 Transmission Control ECU Malfunction
DTC
P3102-525 Transmission Control ECU Malfunction
DTC
P3102-581 Transmission Control ECU Malfunction
DTC
P3102-582 Transmission Control ECU Malfunction
DTC
P3102-597 Transmission Control ECU Malfunction
DTC
P3102-598 Transmission Control ECU Malfunction
DTC
P3102-599 Transmission Control ECU Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
When a signal is input from the P position switch or selector lever, the HV control ECU transmits a P
position control (PCON) signal to the transmission control ECU assembly. Based on this signal, the
transmission control ECU assembly actuates the shift control actuator in order to mechanically lock or
unlock the counter drive gear in the HV transaxle assembly. If the shift control actuator is in the P position,
the transmission control ECU assembly transmits a P position (PPOS) signal to the HV control ECU.
Transmission Control
ECU Assembly
P Position Switch
HV Control ECU
PCON Signal
HV
PPOS Signal
Selector Lever
HV Transaxle Assembly
P Switch
Signal
Actuator
Position
Signal
Shift Control Actuator
A090456E02
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P3102
524
BEAN communication problem of
transmission control ECU
assembly
•
•
•
•
P3102
525
Transmission control ECU IG
OFF command malfunction
•
•
•
•
P3102
581
Transmission control ECU
malfunction
•
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Transmission control ECU
assembly
HV control ECU
Power source control ECU
Wire harness or connector
Transmission control ECU
assembly
HV control ECU
Power source control ECU
Wire harness or connector
Transmission control ECU
assembly
HV control ECU
Power source control ECU
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P3102
582
P position (PPOS) signal is
logically inconsistent
•
•
•
•
P3102
597
GND short in P position (PPOS)
signal circuit
•
•
•
•
P3102
598
+B short in P position (PPOS)
signal circuit
•
•
•
•
P3102
599
P position (PPOS) signal
malfunction (output pulse is
abnormal)
•
•
•
•
HV–487
Wire harness or connector
Transmission control ECU
assembly
HV control ECU
Power source control ECU
Wire harness or connector
Transmission control ECU
assembly
HV control ECU
Power source control ECU
Wire harness or connector
Transmission control ECU
assembly
HV control ECU
Power source control ECU
Wire harness or connector
Transmission control ECU
assembly
HV control ECU
Power source control ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
HV Control ECU
T4
Transmission Control ECU Assembly
PCON
PPOS
7
9
H17 PCON
LG
J14 J/C
8
W
B
B
B
P6
Power Source Control ECU
W
10
H17 PPOS
HV
W
12 II1
P
5
W
4
4J
2
4I
W
No. 1 Center Connector
A093258E02
HV–488
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU ASSEMBLY AND POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU)
(a) Disconnect the H17 HV control ECU connector.
H17
PCON
PPOS
HV Control ECU Connector
A065743E82
(b) Disconnect the T4 transmission control ECU assembly
connector.
Wire Harness Side:
PCON
PPOS
T4
Transmission Control ECU Assembly Connector
A092055E02
Wire Harness Side:
Power Source Control ECU Connector
HV
P
P6
B079748E02
(c) Disconnect the P6 power source control ECU connector.
(d) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the HV
control ECU connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
PCON (H17-9) - Body ground
Below 1 V
PPOS (H17-10) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(e) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
PCON (H17-9) - PCON (T4-7)
Below 1 Ω
PPOS (H17-10) - PPOS (T4-8)
Below 1 Ω
PPOS (H17-10) - P (P6-5)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
PCON (H17-9) or PCON (T4-7) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
PPOS (H17-10) or PPOS (T4-8) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
PPOS (H17-10) or P (P6-5) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(f) Reconnect the power source control ECU connector.
(g) Reconnect the transmission control ECU assembly
connector.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–489
(h) Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
2
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (CHECK FOR +B SHORT IN WIRE HARNESS)
H17
H14
(a) Inspect the HV control ECU using an oscilloscope.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
GND1
PPOS PCON
HV Control ECU Connector
A093719E13
5 V / Division
CH1
GND
CH2
GND
(c) Check the waveforms of the voltages between the
terminals PCON (H17-9) and GND1 (H14-1), and
terminals PPOS (H17-10) and GND1 (H14-1), of the HV
control ECU connectors, in order to check for +B short in
the signal lines PCON and PPOS.
OK:
No +B short in either PCON or PPOS signal lines.
HINT:
• If there is +B short in the signal line, the output
voltage is constantly between 9 V and 14 V.
• If the signal lines are normal, the waveforms are
displayed as shown in the diagram.
NG
20 ms / Division
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
CH1: PCON Signal Waveform
CH2: PPOS Signal Waveform
A125641E01
OK
3
READ OUTPUT DTC (T/M CONTROL)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
T/M CONTROL / DTC INFO / TROUBLE CODES.
(e) Read DTCs.
Result:
DTCs are output
HV
HV–490
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
YES
GO TO RELEVANT DTC CHART
NO
REPLACE HV CONTROL ECU, TRANSMISSION ECU AND POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU
HV
HV–491
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P3107-213
Airbag ECU Communication Circuit Malfunction
DTC
P3107-214
Airbag ECU Communication Circuit Malfunction
DTC
P3107-215
Airbag ECU Communication Circuit Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU detects a malfunction of the collision signal circuit from the center airbag sensor and
gives warning to the driver.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P3107
213
GND short in communication
circuit between center airbag
sensor and HV control ECU
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Center airbag sensor
P3107
214
Open or +B short in
communication circuit between
center airbag sensor and HV
control ECU
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Center airbag sensor
P3107
215
Abnormal communication signals
between center airbag sensor
and HV control ECU
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Center airbag sensor
WIRING DIAGRAM
Center Airbag Sensor
HV Control ECU
Driver Side
Junction Block
22
GSW2 A18
B
15
1E
3
1E
No. 2 Center Connector
L
14
5L
2
5F
L
20
H14 ABFS
A092110E04
HV
HV–492
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - CENTER
AIRBAG SENSOR)
(a) Disconnect the H14 HV control ECU connector.
H14
HV Control ECU Connector
ABFS
A065748E37
Center
Airbag
Sensor
Connector
(b) Disconnect the A18 center airbag sensor connector.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Measure the voltage between the terminal of the HV
control ECU connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
A18
GSW2
A092062E02
HV
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
ABFS (H14-20) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(e) Turn the power switch OFF.
(f) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
ABFS (H14-20) - GSW2 (A18-22)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
ABFS (H14-20) or GSW2 (A18-22) Body ground
10 kΩ higher
(g) Reconnect the center airbag sensor connector.
(h) Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
NG
OK
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
HV–493
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P3108-535
A/C Amplifier Communication Circuit Malfunction
DTC
P3108-536
A/C Amplifier Communication Circuit Malfunction
DTC
P3108-538
A/C Amplifier Communication Circuit Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU detects a wiring malfunction in the serial communication line of the A/C inverter.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P3108
535
Serial communication malfunction
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
P3108
536
A/C inverter malfunction
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
P3108
538
Open in STB signal circuit
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
WIRING DIAGRAM
A/C Inverter
HV Control ECU
HV
4
CLK I11
G
17
H16 CLK
2
TOECU I11
Y
14
H16 ITE
3
TOINV I11
R
24
H16 ETI
5
STB I11
W
25
H16 STB
A014137E01
HV–494
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - A/C
INVERTER)
(a) Disconnect the H15 and H16 HV control ECU
connectors.
H16
H15
CLK
ETI
ITE
STB
HV Control ECU Connector
A090418E01
Wire Harness Side:
TOECU
TOINV
CLK
STB
I11
A/C Inverter Connector
(b) Disconnect the I11 A/C inverter connector.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the HV
control ECU connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
CLK (H16-17) - Body ground
Below 1 V
ITE (H16-14) - Body ground
Below 1 V
ETI (H15-24) - Body ground
Below 1 V
STB (H15-25) - Body ground
Below 1 V
A092056E02
HV
(e) Turn the power switch OFF.
(f) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
CLK (H16-17) - CLK (I11-4)
Below 1 Ω
ITE (H16-14) - TOECU (I11-2)
Below 1 Ω
ETI (H15-24) - TOINV (I11-3)
Below 1 Ω
STB (H15-25) - STB (I11-5)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
CLK (H16-17) or CLK (I11-4) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
ITE (H16-14) or TOECU (I11-2) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
ETI (H15-24) or TOINV (I11-3) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
STB (H15-25) or STB (I11-5) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(g) Reconnect the A/C inverter connector.
(h) Reconnect the HV control ECU connectors.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–495
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
HV
HV–496
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P3108-537
A/C Amplifier Communication Circuit Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC 3108 (INF 535) (see page HV-491).
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P3108
537
Air conditioning amplifier
malfunction
•
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
If the information (INF) code is present, replace the air conditioning amplifier.
1
REPLACE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
NEXT
COMPLETED
HV
Air conditioning amplifier
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P3108-594
HV–497
A/C Amplifier Communication Circuit Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
HINT:
DTC P3108 (INF 594) is one of the DTCs that indicate CAN communication malfunction.
Since the air conditioning amplifier is connected to BEAN (Body Electronics Area Network), the HV control
ECU communicates with it using CAN (Controller Area Network) communication via the gateway ECU.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P3108
594
CAN communication malfunction
•
CAN communication
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ OUTPUT DTC (CODES ALL)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
CODES (All).
(e) Read and record CAN communication malfunction
DTCs.
HINT:
When DTCs other than CAN communication malfunction
DTCs are output simultaneously, first correct the CAN
communication problem, and then perform
troubleshooting for other DTCs.
GO
GO TO CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
HV
HV–498
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P3110-223 IGCT Relay Malfunction
DTC
P3110-527 HV Main Relay Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU monitors the IGCT relay and IG2 relay to detect malfunction.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P3110
223
IGCT relay is always closed
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Integration relay (IGCT relay)
P3110
527
IG2 logical inconsistency
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Integration relay (IG2 relay)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to the wiring diagram for the IG2 relay (see page HV-184).
B
L
A
1 BE1
1
B
1 3M
120 A
MAIN
HV
O
W
F15
Fusible
Link Block
1
20 A
HEV
60 A
P/I
2
A
A
L
L
7
H16 +B1
6
H16 +B2
4 3J 2 3J
1 3A 1 3K
1
HV Control ECU
J3
J/C
IGCT
2
3 3J
4
H16 MREL
Engine Room
Relay Block
W-B
Auxiliary Battery
EE
A092111E02
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
If there is a battery voltage at the +B, MREL or IGSW terminal of the HV control ECU even though the
power switch is turned OFF, the circuit is shorted to the +B power supply.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
1
HV–499
INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY (IGCT RELAY AND IG2 RELAY)
(a) Remove the integration relay from the engine room relay
block.
(b) Inspect the IGCT relay.
(1) Measure the resistance between the terminals of
the integration relay.
Standard resistance
Integration Relay
A1
IGCT
HORN
IG2
EFI
A4
A3
A2
B1
B4
B3
B2
A2
A3
A4
B2
B3
B4
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A4 - C1
10 kΩ or higher
A4 - C1
Below 1 Ω
(Apply battery voltage to terminals
A2 and A3)
(c) Inspect the IG2 relay.
(1) Measure the resistance between the terminals of
the integration relay.
Standard resistance
C1
C1
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
B4 - C1
10 kΩ or higher
B4 - C1
Below 1 Ω
(Apply battery voltage to terminals
B2 and B3)
A093724E02
NG
REPLACE INTEGRATION RELAY (IGCT
RELAY OR IG2 RELAY)
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR AFTER INSPECTION (HV CONTROL ECU INTEGRATION RELAY)
HV
HV–500
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P3137-348 Collision Sensor Low Input
DTC
P3138-349 Collision Sensor High Input
DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU checks the line connection of the circuit breaker sensor (collision sensor) signal and
gives warning to the driver if malfunction is detected.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P3137
348
GND short in No. 1 circuit breaker
sensor circuit
•
•
Wire harness or connector
No. 1 circuit breaker sensor
P3138
349
Open or +B short in No. 1 circuit
breaker sensor circuit
•
•
Wire harness or connector
No. 1 circuit breaker sensor
WIRING DIAGRAM
HV Control ECU
W
1
16
H16 AS1G
SIFC3
No. 1 Circuit Breaker Sensor
SIF+
2
Y
15
H16 AS1
HV
A092112E03
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - NO. 1 CIRCUIT
BREAKER SENSOR)
(a) Disconnect the H16 HV control ECU connector.
H16
AS1G
AS1
HV Control ECU Connector
A065745E49
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
(b) Disconnect the C3 No. 1 circuit breaker sensor
connector.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the HV
control ECU connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side:
C3
SIF-
HV–501
SIF+
No. 1 Circuit Breaker Sensor Connector
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
AS1 (H16-15) - Body ground
Below 1 V
AS1G (H16-16) - Body ground
Below 1 V
A092057E02
(e) Turn the power switch OFF.
(f) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
AS1 (H16-15) - SIF+ (C3-2)
Below 1 Ω
AS1G (H16-16) - SIF- (C3-1)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
AS1 (H16-15) or SIF+ (C3-2) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
AS1G (H16-16) or SIF- (C3-1) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
(g) Reconnect the No. 1 circuit breaker sensor connector.
(h) Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
NG
OK
REPLACE NO. 1 CIRCUIT BREAKER SENSOR
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
HV
HV–502
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P3221-314
Generator Inverter Temperature Sensor Circuit
Range / Performance
DTC
P3221-315
Generator Inverter Temperature Sensor Circuit
Range / Performance
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P3222 (INF 313) (see page HV-505).
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P3221
314
Sudden change in generator
inverter temperature sensor
output
•
•
•
•
•
•
P3221
315
Generator inverter temperature
sensor output deviation
•
•
•
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter cooling system
Water pump with motor
assembly
Cooling fan motor
No. 2 cooling fan motor
Inverter with converter
assembly
Wire harness or connector
Inverter cooling system
Water pump with motor
assembly
Cooling fan motor
No. 2 cooling fan motor
Inverter with converter
assembly
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P3222 (INF 313) (see page HV-505).
HV
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
CHECK QUANTITY OF HV COOLANT
(a) Check that there is a sufficient amount of coolant for the
inverter.
OK:
There is a sufficient amount of coolant for the
inverter
NG
OK
ADD HV COOLANT
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
2
HV–503
CHECK COOLANT HOSE
(a) Check that the hoses of the cooling system are not bent
or clogged (refer to the cooling system [see page HV346]).
OK:
The hoses of the cooling system are not bent or
clogged
NG
CORRECT TO NORMAL CONDITION
OK
3
CHECK CONNECTION CONDITION OF WATER PUMP CONNECTOR (LOOSENESS AND
POOR CONTACT)
(a) Check the connection condition of the water pump
connector.
OK:
Connector has been connected securely and there
is no poor connection.
NG
CONNECT SECURELY
A090415E01
OK
4
CHECK WATER PUMP WITH MOTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Check the operation of the water pump.
OK:
Coolant is sloshing in the reservoir tank
NG
OK
REPLACE WATER PUMP WITH MOTOR
ASSEMBLY
HV
HV–504
5
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK CONNECTION CONDITION OF COOLING FAN MOTOR CONNECTOR
(LOOSENESS AND POOR CONTACT)
(a) Check the connection condition of the cooling fan motor
connectors.
OK:
Connectors have been connected securely and
there is no poor connection.
NG
CONNECT SECURELY
A090546E01
OK
6
INSPECT COOLING FAN MOTOR
(a) Inspect the cooling fan motor (see page CO-5).
NG
REPLACE COOLING FAN MOTOR AND ADD
ENGINE COOLANT
OK
7
INSPECT NO. 2 COOLING FAN MOTOR
(a) Inspect the No. 2 cooling fan motor (see page CO-5).
HV
NG
REPLACE NO. 2 COOLING FAN MOTOR AND
ADD ENGINE COOLANT
OK
8
CHECK CONNECTION CONDITION OF HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU CONNECTOR
(LOOSENESS AND POOR CONTACT)
(a) Check the connection condition of all the connectors at
the HV control ECU.
OK:
Connectors have been connected securely and
there is no poor connection.
NG
HV Control ECU Connector
A093719E09
OK
CONNECT SECURELY
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
9
HV–505
CHECK CONNECTION CONDITION OF INVERTER CONNECTOR (LOOSENESS AND
POOR CONTACT)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
(d) Check the connection condition of the I9 and I10 inverter
connectors.
OK:
Connectors have been connected securely and
there is no poor connection.
I10
I9
NG
CONNECT SECURELY
Inverter Connector
A092044E02
OK
10
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - INVERTER)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Check that the service plug grip and inverter cover have
been removed.
(b) Disconnect the H15 HV control ECU connector.
H15
GIVT
GINV
HV Control ECU Connector
A065744E41
HV
HV–506
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Wire Harness Side:
I10
I9
GINV
I10
GIVT
Inverter Connector
A092063E06
(c) Disconnect the I9 and I10 inverter connectors.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(e) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the HV
control ECU connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
GIVT (H15-27) - Body ground
Below 1 V
GINV (H15-23) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(f) Turn the power switch OFF.
(g) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
GIVT (H15-27) - GIVT (I10-21)
Below 1 Ω
GINV (H15-23) - GINV (I10-16)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
GIVT (H15-27) or GIVT (I10-21) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
GINV (H15-23) or GINV (I10-16) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(h)
(i)
(j)
(k)
HV
Reconnect the inverter connectors.
Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–507
DTC
P3222-313
Generator Inverter Temperature Sensor Circuit
High / Low
DTC
P3223-312
Generator Inverter Temperature Sensor Circuit
High
DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU uses a temperature sensor, which is built into the inverter, to detect the temperature
of the generator inverter. The same cooling system that is routed to the MG1 and MG2 cools the inverter.
This cooling system is independent from the engine cooling system.
The characteristic of the generator inverter temperature sensor is the same as the boost converter
temperature sensor (see page HV-350).
The HV control ECU limits the load based on the signals transmitted by the generator inverter
temperature sensor, in order to check the effectiveness of the inverter cooling system and prevent the
inverter from overheating. Furthermore, the HV control ECU detects a malfunction in the wiring of the
generator inverter temperature sensor, as well as in the sensor itself.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P3222
313
Open or GND short in generator
inverter temperature sensor
circuit
•
•
P3223
312
+B short in generator inverter
temperature sensor circuit
•
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
HV control ECU
Wire harness or connector
Inverter with converter
assembly
HV control ECU
HINT:
After confirming DTC P3222 (INF 313) or P3223 (INF 312), confirm MG1 INVERT TEMP in DIAGNOSIS /
OBD/MOBD / HV ECU / DATA LIST using the intelligent tester.
HV
Temperature Displayed
Malfunction
-50°C (-58°F)
+B short circuit
205°C (401°F)
Open or GND short circuit
WIRING DIAGRAM
Inverter
HV Control ECU
(Shielded)
21
GIVT I10
27
H15 GIVT
W
(Shielded)
16
GINV I10
23
H15 GINV
Y
J5
J/C
A
A
IK
A092100E04
HV–508
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (MG1 INVERT TEMP)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DATA LIST.
(e) Read the MG1 INVERT TEMP value.
Result
Temperature Displayed
Proceed to
-50°C (-58°F)
A
205°C (401°F)
B
-49°C to 204°C (-57°F to 400°F)
C
HINT:
• If there is a +B short circuit, the intelligent tester
indicates -50°C (-58°F).
• If there is an open or GND short circuit, the intelligent
tester indicates 205°C (401°F).
HV
B
C
Go to step 4
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
A
2
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (CHECK FOR +B SHORT IN WIRE HARNESS)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–509
(d) Disconnect the I10 inverter connector.
Wire Harness Side:
I10
GINV
I10
GIVT
Inverter Connector
A092041E33
Generator Inverter
Temperature Sensor
HV Control ECU
GIVT
GINV
A125426E05
(e) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(f) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DATA LIST.
(g) Read the MG1 INVERT TEMP value.
OK:
205°C (401°F)
(h) Turn the power switch OFF.
(i) Reconnect the inverter connector.
(j) Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
(k) Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
NG
3
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (CHECK FOR +B SHORT IN HYBRID VEHICLE
CONTROL ECU)
(a) Disconnect the H15 HV control ECU connector.
H15
GIVT
GINV
HV Control ECU Connector
A065744E41
HV
HV–510
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Generator Inverter
Temperature Sensor
HV Control ECU
GIVT
GINV
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(c) Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
HV ECU / DATA LIST.
(d) Read the MG1 INVERT TEMP value.
OK:
205°C (401°F)
(e) Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
NG
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
A126232E04
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR CONNECTOR
4
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - INVERTER)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
(d) Disconnect the H15 HV control ECU connector.
HV
H15
GIVT
GINV
HV Control ECU Connector
A065744E41
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–511
(e) Disconnect the I10 inverter connector.
(f) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Wire Harness Side:
I10
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
GIVT (H15-27) - GIVT (I10-21)
Below 1 Ω
GINV (H15-23) - GINV (I10-16)
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance (Check for short)
GINV
I10
GIVT
Inverter Connector
A092041E33
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
GIVT (H15-27) or GIVT (I10-21) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
GINV (H15-23) or GINV (I10-16) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(g)
(h)
(i)
(j)
Reconnect the inverter connector.
Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
5
CHECK HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU (GIVT VOLTAGE)
H15
GINV (-)
GIVT (+)
HV Control ECU Connector
A093719E05
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(b) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the H15
HV control ECU connector.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
GIVT (H15-27) - GINV (H15-23)
2.0 to 4.5 V
NG
OK
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
HV
HV–512
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC
P3226-562 DC/DC Boost Converter Temperature Sensor
DTC
P3226-563 DC/DC Boost Converter Temperature Sensor
DESCRIPTION
Refer to DTC P0A94 (INF 583) (see page HV-395).
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
P3226
562
Sudden change in boost
converter temperature sensor
output
•
•
•
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter cooling system
Water pump with assembly
Cooling fan motor
No. 2 cooling fan motor
Inverter with converter
assembly
P3226
563
Boost converter temperature
sensor output deviation
•
•
•
Wire harness or connector
Inverter cooling system
Water pump with motor
assembly
Cooling fan motor
No. 2 cooling fan motor
Inverter with converter
assembly
•
•
•
WIRING DIAGRAM
Refer to DTC P0A94 (INF 583) (see page HV-396).
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HV
CAUTION:
• Before inspecting the high-voltage system, take safety precautions to prevent electrical
shocks, such as wearing insulated gloves and removing the service plug grip. After removing
the service plug grip, put it in your pocket to prevent other technicians from reconnecting it
while you are servicing the high-voltage system.
• After disconnecting the service plug grip, wait for at least 5 minutes before touching any of the
high-voltage connectors or terminals.
HINT:
At least 5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage condenser inside the inverter.
1
CHECK QUANTITY OF HV COOLANT
(a) Check that there is a sufficient amount of coolant for the
inverter.
OK:
There is a sufficient amount of coolant for the
inverter
NG
ADD HV COOLANT
OK
2
CHECK COOLANT HOSE
(a) Check that the hoses of the cooling system are not bent
or clogged (refer to the cooling system [see page HV346]).
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–513
OK:
The hoses of the cooling system are not bent or
clogged
NG
CORRECT TO NORMAL CONDITION
OK
3
CHECK CONNECTION CONDITION OF WATER PUMP CONNECTOR (LOOSENESS AND
POOR CONTACT)
(a) Check the connection condition of the water pump
connector.
OK:
Connector has been connected securely and there
is no poor connection.
NG
CONNECT SECURELY
A090415E01
OK
4
CHECK WATER PUMP WITH MOTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Check the operation of the water pump.
OK:
Coolant is sloshing in the reservoir tank
NG
REPLACE WATER PUMP WITH MOTOR
ASSEMBLY
OK
5
CHECK CONNECTION CONDITION OF COOLING FAN MOTOR CONNECTOR
(LOOSENESS AND POOR CONTACT)
(a) Check the connection condition of the cooling fan motor
connectors.
OK:
Connectors have been connected securely and
there is no poor connection.
NG
A090546E01
OK
CONNECT SECURELY
HV
HV–514
6
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECT COOLING FAN MOTOR
(a) Inspect the cooling fan motor (see page CO-5).
NG
REPLACE COOLING FAN MOTOR AND ADD
ENGINE COOLANT
OK
7
INSPECT NO. 2 COOLING FAN MOTOR
(a) Inspect the No. 2 cooling fan motor (see page CO-5).
NG
REPLACE NO. 2 COOLING FAN MOTOR AND
ADD ENGINE COOLANT
OK
8
CHECK CONNECTION CONDITION OF HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU CONNECTOR
(LOOSENESS AND POOR CONTACT)
(a) Check the connection condition of all the connectors at
the HV control ECU.
OK:
Connectors have been connected securely and
there is no poor connection.
NG
HV
CONNECT SECURELY
HV Control ECU Connector
A093719E09
OK
9
CHECK CONNECTION CONDITION OF INVERTER CONNECTOR (LOOSENESS AND
POOR CONTACT)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NOTICE:
Turning the power switch ON (READY) with the
service plug grip removed could cause malfunction.
Therefore, never turn the power switch ON (READY)
in this state.
(c) Remove the inverter cover (see page HV-531).
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–515
(d) Check the connection condition of the I9 and I10 inverter
connectors.
OK:
Connectors have been connected securely and
there is no poor connection.
I10
I9
NG
CONNECT SECURELY
Inverter Connector
A092044E02
OK
10
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - INVERTER)
CAUTION:
Wear insulated gloves before performing the following
operation.
(a) Check that the service plug grip and inverter cover have
been removed.
(b) Disconnect the H16 HV control ECU connector.
H16
GCNV
CT
HV Control ECU Connector
A065745E51
Wire Harness Side:
I10
I9
CT
I10
Inverter Connector
GCNV
A092063E07
(c) Disconnect the I9 and I10 inverter connectors.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
HINT:
DTCs for the interlock switch system are output when
turning the power switch ON (IG) with both service plug
grip and inverter cover removed.
(e) Measure the voltage between the terminals of the HV
control ECU connector and body ground.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
CT (H16-21) - Body ground
Below 1 V
GCNV (H16-8) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(f) Turn the power switch OFF.
(g) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance (Check for open)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
CT (H16-21) - CT (I10-14)
Below 1 Ω
GCNV (H16-8) - GCNV (I10-32)
Below 1 Ω
Standard (Check for short)
HV
HV–516
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
CT (H16-21) or CT (I10-14) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
GCNV (H16-8) or GCNV (I10-32) Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
(h)
(i)
(j)
(k)
Reconnect the inverter connectors.
Reconnect the HV control ECU connector.
Reinstall the inverter cover (see page HV-538).
Reinstall the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS OR
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
HV
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–517
DTC
U0100-211 Lost Communication with ECM / PCM "A"
DTC
U0100-212 Lost Communication with ECM / PCM "A"
DTC
U0100-530 Lost Communication with ECM / PCM "A"
DTC
U0111-208
Lost Communication with Battery Energy Control Module "A"
DTC
U0111-531
Lost Communication with Battery Energy Control Module "A"
DTC
U0129-220
Lost Communication with Brake System Control Module
DTC
U0129-222
Lost Communication with Brake System Control Module
DTC
U0129-528
Lost Communication with Brake System Control Module
DTC
U0129-529
Lost Communication with Brake System Control Module
DTC
U0131-433
Lost Communication with Power Steering Control Module
DTC
U0131-434
Lost Communication with Power Steering Control Module
DTC
U0146-435 Lost Communication with Gateway "A"
DESCRIPTION
The HV control ECU transmits and receives signals to and from the ECM, battery ECU, skid control ECU,
power steering ECU, and the gateway ECU via CAN (Controller Area Network) communication.
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
U0100
211
CAN communication problem
between ECM and HV control
ECU (no signal input)
•
CAN communication system
U0100
212
CAN communication problem
between ECM and HV control
ECU (transmission error)
•
CAN communication system
HV
HV–518
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
DTC No.
INF Code
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
U0100
530
CAN communication problem
between ECM and HV control
ECU (CAN communication
system malfunction)
•
CAN communication system
U0111
208
CAN communication problem
between battery ECU and HV
control ECU (no signal input)
•
CAN communication system
U0111
531
CAN communication problem
between battery ECU and HV
control ECU (CAN
communication system
malfunction)
•
CAN communication system
U0129
220
CAN communication problem
between skid control ECU and
HV control ECU (no signal input)
•
CAN communication system
U0129
222
CAN communication problem
between skid control ECU and
HV control ECU (CAN
communication system
malfunction)
•
CAN communication system
U0129
528
CAN communication problem
between skid control ECU and
HV control ECU (transmission
error)
•
CAN communication system
U0129
529
CAN communication problem
between skid control ECU and
HV control ECU (regenerative
torque malfunction)
•
CAN communication system
U0131
433
CAN communication problem
between power steering ECU and
HV control ECU (no signal input)
•
CAN communication system
U0131
434
CAN communication problem
between power steering ECU and
HV control ECU (CAN
communication system
malfunction)
•
CAN communication system
U0146
435
CAN communication problem
between gateway ECU and HV
control ECU (no signal input)
•
CAN communication system
HV
MONITOR DESCRIPTION
If the HV control ECU detects a malfunction in the CAN communication with the ECM or battery ECU, it
illuminates the MIL and sets a DTC.
MONITOR STRATEGY
U0100:
Related DTCs
U0100 (INF 211):
Receiving check for the specific frame
U0100 (INF 212):
Sending data check
U0100 (INF 530):
Receiving check for the all frame
Required sensor / components
Main: ECM
Sub: CAN bus line
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
U0100 (INF 211, 212): 0.1 second or more
U0100 (INF 530): 1.91 seconds or more
MIL operation
1 driving cycle
Sequence of operation
None
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
HV–519
U0111:
Related DTCs
U0111 (INF 208):
Receiving check for the specific frame
U0111 (INF 531):
Receiving check for the all frame
Required sensor / components
Main: Battery ECU
Sub: CAN bus line
Frequency of operation
Continuous
Duration
U0111 (INF 208): 0.1 second or more
U0111 (INF 531): 1.6 seconds or more
MIL operation
1 driving cycle
Sequence of operation
None
TYPICAL ENABLING CONDITIONS
The monitor will run whenever the following DTCs are not present
TOYOTA's intellectual property
Other conditions belong to TOYOTA's intellectual property
-
TYPICAL MALFUNCTION THRESHOLDS
CAN communication
Communication failure
COMPONENT OPERATING RANGE
ECM
DTC U0100 (INF 211 / 212 / 530) is not detected
Battery ECU
DTC U0111 (INF 208 / 531) is not detected
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
HV
READ OUTPUT DTC (CODES ALL)
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester ON.
Enter the following menus: DIAGNOSIS / OBD/MOBD /
CODES (All).
(e) Read and record CAN communication malfunction
DTCs.
Result:
Display (DTC Output)
Proceed to
U0100 (INF 211) or U0129 (INF 220)
A
U0100 (INF 211) and CAN communication malfunction DTCs
B
U0129 (INF 220) and CAN communication malfunction DTCs
B
P3108 (INF 594) and CAN communication malfunction DTCs
B
HINT:
• When DTCs other than CAN communication
malfunction DTCs are output simultaneously, first
correct the CAN communication problem, and then
perform troubleshooting for other DTCs.
• DTC P3108 (INF 594) is one of the DTCs that
indicates a CAN communication malfunction.
HV–520
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
B
GO TO CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
A
2
CHECK TERMINAL OF ECM AND ECUS (+B1, +B2, CANH AND CANL TERMINALS)
H14
H16
+B1
+B2
CANL
CANH
HV Control ECU Connector
E6
(a) Check connection condition of each connector of the HV
control ECU, ECM and battery ECU, as well as contact
condition of each terminal shown in the table.
Type of ECU
Terminal No.
Symbols
HV control ECU
H16-7
+B1
HV control ECU
H16-6
+B2
HV control ECU
H14-8
CANH
HV control ECU
H14-9
CANL
ECM
E6-31
CANH
ECM
E6-30
CANL
Battery ECU
B11-18
CANH
Battery ECU
B11-19
CANL
OK:
Connectors have been connected securely and
there is no poor contact on each terminal.
CANH
CANL
ECM Connector
B11
HV
CANL
CANH
Battery ECU Connector
A126988E01
OK
CHECK FOR INTERMITTENT PROBLEMS
NG
CONNECT SECURELY
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
HV–519
INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
PRECAUTION
CAUTION:
The hybrid system uses high voltage circuits, so
improper handling could cause an electric shock or
leakage. During servicing (e.g. installing or removing
parts, inspection, replacing parts), be sure to follow the
procedures below.
1. DISCONNECT POWER SOURCE WHEN
PERFORMING WORK ON HIGH VOLTAGE SYSTEM
(a) Ensure that the power switch is OFF.
(b) Disconnect the negative terminal cable from the
auxiliary battery (see page HB-153).
(c) Always wear insulating gloves (see below).
NOTICE:
DTCs will also be erased, so if necessary check
DTCs before disconnecting the power source
OFF.
(d) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-153).
NOTICE:
• After removing the service plug grip, do not
operate the power switch as it may damage
the hybrid vehicle control ECU.
• Keep the removed service plug grip in your
pocket to prevent other technicians from
reconnecting it while you are servicing the
vehicle.
(e) Leave the vehicle for 5 minutes.
HINT:
It takes 5 minutes for the high voltage condenser in
the inverter to discharge its electricity.
2.
3.
D020384E01
4.
PRECAUTIONS FOR INSULATING GLOVES
(a) Before wearing, ensure that the insulating gloves
are not damaged with tears, holes or cracks.
(b) Do not wear wet gloves.
PRECAUTIONS FOR WIRE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
(a) The wire harnesses and connectors with high
voltage circuits are colored orange. In addition, high
voltage parts such as the HV battery are affixed with
a "High Voltage" caution label. Be careful not to
touch these wires.
PRECAUTIONS WHEN PERFORMING SERVICE OR
INSPECTIONS
(a) Always disconnect the power source before starting
work (see above).
(b) Always wear insulating gloves when inspecting or
servicing any high voltage wires and parts.
(c) Alert other technicians that you are working on the
high voltage systems with a warning sign such as
"High Voltage Work: Do Not Touch".
HV
HV–520
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
(d) Do not carry any metal objects such as a
mechanical pencil or a measuring tape that could
fall and cause a short circuit.
(e) After removing any high voltage wires, insulate them
immediately with insulation tape.
(f) Always tighten the high voltage screw terminals to
the specified torque. Insufficient or excessive torque
will cause malfunctions.
(g) After finishing work on the high voltage systems and
before reinstalling the service plug, reconfirm that
you have not left any parts or tools lying around, that
the high voltage terminals are tightened and that the
connectors are connected.
HV
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
HV–521
COMPONENTS
REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD
REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD
REAR DECK FLOOR BOX
HV
6.0 (61, 53 in.*lbf)
NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
SERVICE PLUG GRIP
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A124443E01
HV–522
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
FRONT WIPER ARM COVER
FRONT WIPER ARM RH
FRONT WIPER ARM LH
21 (56, 16)
21 (56, 16)
x2
HOOD TO COWL TOP SEAL
COWL TOP VENTILATOR
LOUVER LH
COWL TOP
VENTILATOR
LOUVER RH
x5
HV
WIPER MOTOR CONNECTOR
8.4 (86, 74 in.*lbf)
FRONT WIPER LINK
AND WIPER MOTOR
ASSEMBLY
FRONT COWL TOP PANEL OUTER
6.4 (65, 57 in.*lbf)
ENGINE ROOM NO. 2
RELAY BLOCK
x2
8.4 (86, 74 in.*lbf)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A124444E01
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
x 12
HV–523
11 (112, 8.1)
INVERTER COVER
11 (112, 8.1)
NO. 2 INVERTER COOLING HOSE
ENGINE ROOM MAIN
WIRE HARNESS
HV
NO. 1 CIRCUIT BREAKER SENSOR
CONNECTOR
NO. 1 INVERTER
COOLING HOSE
NO. 6 INVERTER COOLING HOSE
x6
HOOD TO COWL TOP SEAL
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A124445E01
HV–524
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
21 (214, 16)
21 (214, 16)
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
21 (214, 16)
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
HV
MG2 POWER CABLE
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ASSEMBLY
MG1 POWER CABLE
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A124446E01
HV–525
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
NO. 1 INVERTER BRACKET
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
25 (255, 18)
HV
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
NO. 1 CIRCUIT BREAKER SENSOR
BRACKET
25 (255, 18)
NO. 2 INVERTER BRACKET
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A124447E01
HV–526
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT INVERTER
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
HINT:
Check DTCs before performing the inspections on the
converter and inverter, and perform the appropriate
troubleshooting.
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-153).
(c) Remove the inverter cover.
(1) Using a T30 "torx" socket, remove the screw.
(2) Remove the 12 bolts and inverter cover.
Torx Screw
A083598E01
Connector A
Connector C
HV
Connector B
A092562E01
(d) Disconnect connectors A and B shown in the
illustration.
(e) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
If turning the power switch ON (IG) with the service
plug grip removed, the DTC of the interlock switch
system will be output.
(f) Using a voltmeter, measure the voltage. Also, using
an ohmmeter, measure the resistance.
NOTICE:
The inspection should be performed on the wire
harness side, not on the terminal side.
HV–527
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
MIVB
MUU
MVU
MWU
MIVA
GWU
GVU
GUU
VH
GIVB
CPWM
GSDN
VL
GIVA
GINV
GCNV
GIWA
GIWB
CT
FCV
GIVT
CSDN
GFIV
OVH
MIWA
MFIV
MIWB
MIVT
MSDN
OVL
GND
ILK
Connector B
IGCT
Connector C
Connector A
A133543E01
Standard condition
Tester Connection
Measuring Condition
Specified Condition
A-2 (GIVA) - A-16 (GINV)
-
Approximately 0 V
A-3 (GIVB) - A-16 (GINV)
-
Approximately 0 V
A-4 (GUU) - A-16 (GINV)
-
Approximately 14 to 16 V
A-5 (GVU) - A-16 (GINV)
-
Approximately 14 to 16 V
A-6 (GWU) - A-16 (GINV)
-
Approximately14 to 16 V
A-7 (MIVA) - A-16 (GINV)
-
Approximately 0 V
A-8 (MIVB) - A-16 (GINV)
-
Approximately 0 V
A-9 (MUU) - A-16 (GINV)
-
Approximately 14 to 16 V
A-10 (MVU) - A-16 (GINV)
-
Approximately 14 to 16 V
A-11 (MWU) - A-16 (GINV)
-
Approximately 14 to 16 V
A-12 (VH) - A-16 (GINV)
-
Approximately 0.5 V
A-13 (CPWM) - A-32 (GCNV)
-
Approximately 0 V
A-14 (GSDN) - A-32 (GCNV)
-
Approximately 2 to 4.5 V
A-15 (VL) - A-32 (GCNV)
-
Approximately 0.5 V
A-16 (GINV) - C-2 (GND)
-
Approximately 0 V
A-18 (GIWA) - A-16 (GINV)
-
Approximately 0 V
A-19 (GIWB) - A-16 (GINV)
-
Approximately 0 V
A-20 (CT) - A-16 (GINV)
-
Approximately 0 V
A-21 (GIVT) - A-16 (GINV)
-
Approximately 2 to 4.5 V
A-22 (GFIV) - A-16 (GINV)
-
Approximately 5 to 8 V
A-23 (MIWA) - A-16 (GINV)
-
Approximately 0 V
A-24 (MIWB) - A-16 (GINV)
-
Approximately 0 V
A-25 (MSDN) - A-16 (GINV)
-
Approximately 0 V
HV
HV–528
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
Tester Connection
Measuring Condition
A-26 (MIVT) - A-16 (GINV)
-
Specified Condition
Approximately 2 to 4.5 V
A-27 (MFIV) - A-16 (GINV)
-
Approximately 5 to 8 V
A-28 (OVH) - A-16 (GINV)
-
Approximately 5 to 8 V
A-29 (CSDN) - A-32 (GCNV)
-
Approximately 0 V
A-30 (FCV) - A-32 (GCNV)
-
Approximately 13.5 to 16.5 V
A-31 (OVL) - A-32 (GCNV)
-
Approximately 13.5 to 16.5 V
A-32 (GCNV) - C-2 (GND)
-
Approximately 0 V
B-1 (ILK) - Body ground
After installing the probe to the
terminal, temporarily install the
inverter cover. It does not have
to be tightened with the bolts at
this point.
Below 1 Ω
C-1 (IGCT) - C-2 (GND)
-
Approximately 8 to 16 V
C-2 (GND) - Body ground
-
Below 1 Ω
If the standards are not met, replace the inverter
with converter assembly.
2.
Combination Meter
INSPECT CONVERTER
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
HINT:
If the HV system warning, master warning light and
charge warning come on at the same time, check the
DTCs and perform the appropriate troubleshooting.
Master Warning Light
Multi Information Display
HV
HV System Warning
Charge Warning
A133181E01
(a) Check the operation.
(1) Using a voltmeter, measure the voltage of the
auxiliary battery terminal when the "READY"
light is OFF and ON.
Standard voltage
“READY” Light
"READY" Light
A077557E01
Specified Condition
ON
14 V
OFF
12 V
HINT:
When the "READY" light is ON, the converter
outputs the voltage. When it is OFF, the
auxiliary battery outputs the voltage.
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
HV–529
(b) Inspect the output current.
(1) Remove the 5 bolts, and disconnect the MG1
power cables from the inverter.
CAUTION:
• Wear insulating gloves.
• Insulate the connector parts with
insulating tape.
A083601E02
(2) Remove the 5 bolts, and disconnect the MG2
power cable.
CAUTION:
• Wear insulating gloves.
• Insulate the connector parts with
insulating tape.
A083600E02
A077564E01
(3) Install a voltmeter and the AC/DC 400 A probe
to the locations shown in the illustration.
(4) Connect the MG1 power cable to the MG1
power cable terminal with the 5 bolts.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(5) Connect the MG2 power cable to the MG2
power cable terminal with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(6) With the "READY" light ON, operate the 12 V
electrical devices one by one, and then
measure the output current.
Standard ampere:
Approximately 80 A or less
HINT:
If the output current is 0 A or greater than 80 A,
check the input/output signal.
(c) Check the input/output signal.
(1) Disconnect the connectors shown in the
illustration.
(2) Using a voltmeter, measure the voltage
between the body ground and the terminal of
the vehicle side wire harness connector.
Standard condition:
Equal to the auxiliary battery terminal
voltage
A077564E01
HV
HV–530
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
(3) Disconnect the connectors shown in the
illustration.
A077563E01
IGCT
(4) Turn the power switch ON (IG). Using a
voltmeter and ohmmeter, measure the voltage
and resistance between the connector
terminals on the vehicle harness side.
Standard condition
S
1
2
3
4 5
6
Tester Connection
NODD
G100865E02
Specified Condition
1 (IGCT) - Body ground
8 to 16 V
3 (S) - Body ground
Equal to the auxiliary battery voltage
4 (NODD) - Body ground
120 to 140 kΩ (when power switch is
OFF)
If the standards are not met, replace the
inverter with converter assembly.
HV
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
HV–531
REMOVAL
CAUTION:
• When working on high voltage systems, always wear
insulating gloves.
• Keep the removed service plug in your pocket to
prevent other technicians from reconnecting it while
you are servicing the vehicle.
• After removing the service plug grip, do not touch the
high voltage connectors and terminals for 5 minutes.
NOTICE:
After removing the service plug grip, do not operate the
power switch as it may damage the hybrid vehicle
control ECU.
1.
PRECAUTION
CAUTION:
The hybrid system uses high voltage circuits, so
improper handling could cause an electric shock or
leakage. During service (including installation/
removal, inspection and replacement of parts), be
sure to follow the procedures (see page HV-1).
2.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
3.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
4.
DRAIN HV COOLANT (See page HX-58)
5.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
6.
REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-4)
7.
REMOVE REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
8.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
9.
REMOVE SERVICE PLUG GRIP (See page HB-154)
10. REMOVE FRONT WIPER ARM COVER
11. REMOVE FRONT WIPER ARM RH (See page WW-13)
12. REMOVE FRONT WIPER ARM LH (See page WW-13)
13. REMOVE HOOD TO COWL TOP SEAL (See page
WW-13)
14. REMOVE COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER LH (See
page WW-13)
15. REMOVE COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER RH (See
page WW-13)
16. REMOVE FRONT WIPER LINK AND WIPER MOTOR
ASSEMBLY (See page WW-13)
HV
HV–532
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
17. REMOVE FRONT COWL TOP PANEL OUTER (See
page FU-12)
18. REMOVE RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
19. REMOVE INVERTER COVER
(a) Using a T30 "torx" socket, remove the screw.
(b) Remove the 12 bolts and inverter cover.
Torx Screw
A083598E01
20. VERIFY THAT VOLTAGE OF INVERTER WITH
CONVERTER IS 0 V
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(a) Using a voltmeter, measure the voltage of the high
voltage DC line.
Standard voltage:
0V
HINT:
Use a measuring range of DC 400 V or more on the
voltmeter.
A092565E01
HV
(b) Using the voltmeter, measure the voltage between
the terminals of the three phase connector (U - V, V
- W, U - W).
Standard voltage:
0V
HINT:
Use a measuring range of DC 400 V or more on the
voltmeter.
A077532E01
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
HV–533
21. DISCONNECT NO. 2 INVERTER COOLING HOSE
A083552E01
22. DISCONNECT NO. 1 INVERTER COOLING HOSE
A083602E01
23. DISCONNECT NO. 6 INVERTER COOLING HOSE
HV
A083557E01
24. DISCONNECT NO. 1 CIRCUIT BREAKER SENSOR
(a) Move the outer section to the wire harness side as
illustrated, and then disconnect the circuit breaker
sensor.
Outer Section
A083556E01
A083553E01
25. DISCONNECT FRAME WIRE
CAUTION:
• Wear insulating gloves.
• After removing the service plug grip, be sure to
wait for at least 5 minutes before performing any
work.
• Insulate the electrode and connector parts with
insulating tape.
(a) Remove the 2 frame wire connectors from the
inverter with converter assembly.
HV–534
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
Lock Pin
26. REMOVE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a small screwdriver, lift up the lock pin (green)
as illustrated to unlock it.
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(b) Disconnect the connector for the air conditioning
inverter.
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
A083603E01
(c) Disconnect the 3 connectors shown in the
illustration.
A083554E01
(d) Disconnect the 3 connectors shown in the
illustration and the engine main wire harness.
HV
A083555E01
(e) Remove the 5 bolts, then disconnect the MG2
power cable.
CAUTION:
• Wear insulating gloves.
• Insulate the connector parts with insulating
tape.
A083600E02
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
(f)
HV–535
Remove the 5 bolts, then disconnect the MG1
power cable.
CAUTION:
• Wear insulating gloves.
• Insulate the connector parts with insulating
tape.
A083601E02
(g) Remove the 3 bolts and the inverter with converter
assembly.
A083599E01
(h) Disconnect the connector for the air conditioning
inverter from the bracket.
(i) Remove the bolt and connector bracket for the air
conditioning inverter.
HV
A083573E01
27. REMOVE NO. 1 INVERTER BRACKET
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and inverter bracket.
A083578E01
28. REMOVE NO. 2 INVERTER BRACKET
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and inverter bracket.
A083577E01
HV–536
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
29. REMOVE NO. 1 CIRCUIT BREAKER SENSOR
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and circuit breaker sensor.
A083574E01
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL NO. 1 CIRCUIT BREAKER SENSOR
(a) Install the circuit breaker sensor with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
2.
INSTALL NO. 2 INVERTER BRACKET
(a) Install the inverter bracket with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 25 N*m (255 kgf*cm, 18 in.*lbf)
3.
INSTALL NO. 1 INVERTER BRACKET
(a) Install the inverter bracket with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 25 N*m (255 kgf*cm, 18 in.*lbf)
4.
INSTALL INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the connector bracket for the air conditioning
inverter with the bolt.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
(b) Install the connector for the air conditioning inverter
on the bracket.
A083574E01
HV
A083577E01
A083578E01
A083573E01
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
HV–537
(c) Install the inverter with converter assembly with the
3 bolts.
Torque: 21 N*m (214 kgf*cm, 16 in.*lbf)
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
A083599E01
(d) Install the MG1 power cable to the MG1 power
cable terminal with the 5 bolts.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
A083601E02
(e) Install the MG2 power cable to the MG2 power
cable terminal with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
HV
A083600E02
(f)
Connect the 3 connectors shown in the illustration.
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(g) Insert the grommet of the engine main wire harness
into the U-shaped groove of the inverter case.
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
Grommet
A083555E02
(h) Connect the 3 connectors shown in the illustration.
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(i) Connect the connector for the air conditioning
inverter, then lock the connector with the lock pin.
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
A083554E01
HV–538
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
A083553E01
5.
CONNECT FRAME WIRE
(a) Connect the 2 frame wire connectors to the inverter
with converter assembly.
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
6.
CONNECT NO. 1 CIRCUIT BREAKER SENSOR
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
7.
CONNECT NO. 6 INVERTER COOLING HOSE
8.
CONNECT NO. 1 INVERTER COOLING HOSE
9.
CONNECT NO. 2 INVERTER COOLING HOSE
10. INSTALL INVERTER COVER
(a) Temporarily fasten the inverter cover with the 12
bolts and "torx" screw.
(b) Tighten the 12 bolts.
Torque: 11 N*m (112 kgf*cm, 8.1 in.*lbf)
(c) Using a T30 "torx" socket, tighten the "torx" screw.
Torque: 11 N*m (112 kgf*cm, 8.1 in.*lbf)
11. INSTALL RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
“Torx” Screw
A083598E02
12. INSTALL FRONT COWL TOP PANEL OUTER (See
page FU-19)
13. INSTALL WINDSHIELD WIPER LINK AND WIPER
MOTOR ASSEMBLY (See page WW-16)
14. INSTALL COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER RH
15. INSTALL COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER LH
HV
16. INSTALL HOOD TO COWL TOP SEAL
17. INSTALL FRONT WIPER ARM LH (See page WW-16)
18. INSTALL FRONT WIPER ARM RH (See page WW-16)
19. INSTALL WINDSHIELD WIPER ARM COVER
20. INSTALL SERVICE PLUG GRIP (See page HB-154)
21. CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL (See page CH-7)
22. INSTALL REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
23. INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-8)
24. INSTALL REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
25. ADD HV COOLANT (See page HX-58)
26. CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKAGE (See
page CO-2)
27. INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
28. INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – INVERTER WITH CONVERTER
HV–539
29. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
HV
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
HV–539
HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
HYBRID
P112
HYBRID
SYSTEM
VEHICLE CONTROL
COMPONENTS
UPPER INSTRUMENT
PANEL FINISH PANEL
INSTRUMENT PANEL HOLE COVER
INSTRUMENT PANEL HOLE COVER
GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR
NO. 2 INSTRUMENT
PANEL REGISTER
NO. 4 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
NO. 3 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
HV
INSTRUMENT PANEL CUSHION
NO. 1 INSTRUMENT
PANEL REGISTER
GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR STOPPER
LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL
GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR ASSEMBLY
A131253E01
HV–540
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL SPEAKER
PANEL (w/ JBL Sound System)
FRONT PILLAR GARNISH RH
FRONT PILLAR GARNISH LH
FRONT PILLAR GARNISH CORNER PIECE RH
FRONT PILLAR GARNISH CORNER PIECE LH
20 (204, 15)
HV
INSTRUMENT PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
CLOCK ASSEMBLY
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL END
MULTI-DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B126622E04
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
HV–541
NO. 3 HEATER TO REGISTER DUCT
HV
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
ECM
HYBRID VEHICLE
CONTROL ECU
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A131251E01
HV–542
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
2.
REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-4)
3.
REMOVE REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
4.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
5.
REMOVE NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
(See page IP-5)
6.
REMOVE LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH
PANEL (See page IP-6)
7.
REMOVE UPPER INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH
PANEL (See page IP-6)
8.
REMOVE NO. 3 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
(See page IP-6)
9.
REMOVE NO. 4 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
(See page IP-6)
10. REMOVE NO. 2 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
(See page IP-7)
HV
11. REMOVE MULTI-DISPLAY ASSEMBLY (See page NS172)
12. REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR STOPPER
(See page IP-7)
13. REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-7)
14. REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR (See page
IP-7)
15. REMOVE NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL SPEAKER
PANEL
16. REMOVE FRONT PILLAR GARNISH CORNER PIECE
RH
17. REMOVE FRONT PILLAR GARNISH CORNER PIECE
LH
18. REMOVE FRONT PILLAR GARNISH RH
19. REMOVE FRONT PILLAR GARNISH LH
20. DISCONNECT AIRBAG CONNECTOR
21. REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
(See page IP-8)
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
HV–543
22. REMOVE NO. 3 HEATER TO REGISTER DUCT (See
page AC-147)
23. REMOVE ECM (See page ES-469)
24. REMOVE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
(a) Remove the 2 nuts and hybrid vehicle control ECU.
A077552E01
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
(a) Install the hybrid vehicle control ECU with the 2
nuts.
Torque: 5.5 N*m (56 kgf*cm, 49 in.*lbf)
2.
INSTALL ECM (See page ES-470)
3.
INSTALL NO. 3 HEATER TO REGISTER DUCT (See
page AC-159)
4.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
(See page IP-11)
5.
CONNECT AIRBAG CONNECTOR
6.
INSTALL FRONT PILLAR GARNISH RH
7.
INSTALL FRONT PILLAR GARNISH LH
8.
INSTALL FRONT PILLAR GARNISH CORNER PIECE
RH
9.
INSTALL FRONT PILLAR GARNISH CORNER PIECE
LH
A077552E01
10. INSTALL NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL SPEAKER
PANEL
11. INSTALL GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR (See page
IP-12)
12. INSTALL GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR ASSEMBLY
(See page IP-12)
13. INSTALL GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR STOPPER
14. INSTALL MULTI-DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
15. INSTALL NO. 2 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
(See page IP-12)
16. INSTALL NO. 4 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
(See page IP-12)
17. INSTALL NO. 3 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
(See page IP-13)
HV
HV–544
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
18. INSTALL UPPER INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH
PANEL (See page IP-13)
19. INSTALL LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH
PANEL (See page IP-13)
20. INSTALL NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
(See page IP-13)
21. CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL (See page CH-7)
22. CHECK SRS WARNING LIGHT
23. INSTALL REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
24. INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-8)
25. INSTALL REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
26. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
HV
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – WATER PUMP WITH MOTOR
HV–545
WATER PUMP WITH MOTOR
HYBRID
P112
HYBRID
SYSTEM
VEHICLE CONTROL
COMPONENTS
FRONT FENDER LINER RH
FRONT FENDER LINER LH
FRONT BUMPER
ENERGY ABSORBER
HEADLIGHT ASSEMBLY LH
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
RADIATOR GRILLE PROTECTOR
HV
FRONT BUMPER COVER
CENTER NO. 4 ENGINE UNDER COVER
FRONT SPOILER COVER
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A131149E01
HV–546
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – WATER PUMP WITH MOTOR
INVERTER COOLING HOSE
7.0 (71, 62 in.*lbf)
7.0 (71, 62 in.*lbf)
WATER PUMP WITH
MOTOR CONNECTOR
WATER VALVE WITH
BRACKET ASSEMBLY
INVERTER
COOLING HOSE
WATER PUMP WITH MOTOR
ASSEMBLY
21 (214, 16)
NO. 2 INVERTER BRACKET
25 (255, 18)
HV
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A117423E01
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – WATER PUMP WITH MOTOR
HV–547
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
2.
REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-4)
3.
REMOVE REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
4.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
5.
DISCONNECT FRONT FENDER LINER LH (See page
ET-3)
6.
DISCONNECT FRONT FENDER LINER RH (See page
ET-3)
7.
REMOVE CENTER NO. 4 ENGINE UNDER COVER
(See page ET-3)
8.
REMOVE FRONT SPOILER COVER (See page ET-3)
9.
REMOVE FRONT BUMPER COVER (See page ET-4)
10. REMOVE FRONT BUMPER ENERGY ABSORBER
11. REMOVE HEADLIGHT ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the headlight LH from the vehicle (see
page LI-77).
12. DRAIN HV COOLANT (See page HX-58)
13. DISCONNECT WATER VALVE WITH BRACKET
ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the bolt and nut, then disconnect the water
valve.
A083571E01
14. REMOVE WATER PUMP WITH MOTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the 2 inverter cooling hoses shown in
the illustration.
A083596E01
HV
HV–548
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – WATER PUMP WITH MOTOR
(b) Remove the bolt, then disconnect the water pump
with motor assembly from the vehicle.
(c) Disconnect the connector and remove the water
pump with motor assembly.
Connector
A083597E01
INSPECTION
1.
A053155E02
INSPECT WATER PUMP WITH MOTOR
(a) Check the operation.
(1) Connect the battery positive terminal to
terminal 1 and the battery negative terminal to
terminal 2.
Specified condition:
Pump motor operates properly
NOTICE:
• Do not connect the positive and negative
terminals of the battery to the wrong
water pump terminals.
• Complete the check within 10 seconds of
the connection.
If the pump motor does not operate properly,
replace the water pump with motor assembly.
INSTALLATION
1.
HV
Connector
INSTALL WATER PUMP WITH MOTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Connect the connector.
(b) Install the water pump with motor assembly with the
bolt.
Torque: 7.0 N*m (71 kgf*cm, 62 in.*lbf)
A083597E01
(c) Connect the 2 inverter cooling hoses.
A083596E01
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – WATER PUMP WITH MOTOR
A083571E01
HV–549
2.
INSTALL WATER VALVE WITH BRACKET
ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the water valve with the bolt and nut.
Torque: 7.0 N*m (71 kgf*cm, 62 in.*lbf)
3.
INSTALL HEADLIGHT ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the headlight LH to the vehicle (see page LI82).
4.
INSTALL FRONT BUMPER ENERGY ABSORBER
5.
INSTALL FRONT BUMPER COVER (See page ET-6)
6.
INSTALL FRONT SPOILER COVER (See page ET-7)
7.
INSTALL CENTER NO. 4 ENGINE UNDER COVER
(See page ET-7)
8.
INSTALL FRONT FENDER LINER LH (See page ET-7)
9.
INSTALL FRONT FENDER LINER RH (See page ET-7)
10. ADD HV COOLANT (See page HX-58)
11. CHECK ENGINE COOLANT LEAKAGE (See page CO2)
12. CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL (See page CH-7)
13. INSTALL REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
14. INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-8)
15. INSTALL REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
16. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
HV
HV–550
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – FRAME WIRE
FRAME WIRE
HYBRID
P112
HYBRID
SYSTEM
VEHICLE CONTROL
COMPONENTS
REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD
REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD
REAR DECK FLOOR BOX
HV
6.0 (61, 53 in.*lbf)
NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
SERVICE PLUG GRIP
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A124443E08
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – FRAME WIRE
HV–551
TONNEAU COVER
REAR DECK TRIM COVER
LUGGAGE HOLD BELT
STRIKER
HV
REAR NO. 1 FLOOR BOARD
REAR SEAT CUSHION
ASSEMBLY
A124453E01
HV–552
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – FRAME WIRE
28 (286, 21)
28 (286, 21)
BATTERY CARRIER BRACKET
28 (286, 21)
REAR NO. 4 FLOOR BOARD
DECK FLOOR BOX LH
FLOOR SIDE PANEL LH
HV
DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL LH
REAR SIDE SEATBACK
FRAME LH
LUGGAGE HOLD BELT
STRIKER
REAR DOOR
SCUFF PLATE LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A124461E01
HV–553
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – FRAME WIRE
FRONT WIPER ARM COVER
FRONT WIPER ARM RH
FRONT WIPER ARM LH
21 (56, 16)
21 (56, 16)
x2
HOOD TO COWL TOP SEAL
COWL TOP VENTILATOR
LOUVER LH
COWL TOP
VENTILATOR
LOUVER RH
x5
WIPER MOTOR CONNECTOR
8.4 (86, 74 in.*lbf)
FRONT WIPER
LINK AND WIPER
MOTOR ASSEMBLY
FRONT COWL TOP PANEL OUTER
6.4 (65, 57 in.*lbf)
NO. 2 ENGINE ROOM
RELAY BLOCK
x2
8.4 (86, 74 in.*lbf)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A124444E07
HV
HV–554
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – FRAME WIRE
COLUMN HOLE COVER SILENCER SHEET
35 (360, 26)
35 (360, 26)
STEERING INTERMEDIATE SHAFT
157 (1,601, 116)
113 (1,152, 83)
157 (1,601, 116)
113 (1,152, 83)
HV
FRONT FLOOR COVER CENTER LH
x5
FRONT FLOOR COVER LH
ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
ENGINE UNDER
COVER RH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A124462E01
HV–555
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – FRAME WIRE
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
JUNCTION TERMINAL
NO. 6 BATTERY
CARRIER PANEL
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
5.6 (57, 50 in.*lbf)
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
FRAME WIRE
CLAMP
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
NO. 1 WIRE HARNESS
PROTECTOR
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
WIRE HARNESS
SIDE COVER
FRAME WIRE
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
Non-reusable part
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
CLAMP
A124463E01
HV
HV–556
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – FRAME WIRE
REMOVAL
CAUTION:
• When working on high voltage systems, always wear
insulating gloves.
• Keep the removed service plug in your pocket to
prevent other technicians from reconnecting it while
you are servicing the vehicle.
• After removing the service plug grip, do not touch the
high voltage connectors and terminals for 5 minutes.
NOTICE:
After removing the service plug grip, do not operate the
power switch as it may damage the hybrid vehicle
control ECU.
HV
1.
PRECAUTION
CAUTION:
The hybrid system uses high voltage circuits, so
improper handling could cause an electric shock or
leakage. During service (including installation/
removal, inspection and replacement of parts), be
sure to follow the procedures (see page HV-519).
2.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
3.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
4.
REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-4)
5.
REMOVE REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
6.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
7.
REMOVE SERVICE PLUG GRIP (See page HB-154)
8.
REMOVE REAR DECK TRIM COVER (See page HB88)
9.
REMOVE TONNEAU COVER (See page HB-89)
10. REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY (See
page SE-15)
11. REMOVE REAR NO. 1 FLOOR BOARD (See page HB89)
12. REMOVE REAR SIDE SEATBACK FRAME LH (See
page HB-89)
13. REMOVE REAR NO. 4 FLOOR BOARD (See page HB90)
14. REMOVE DECK FLOOR BOX LH (See page HB-90)
15. REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL LH (See page HB90)
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – FRAME WIRE
HV–557
16. REMOVE BATTERY CARRIER BRACKET (See page
HB-91)
17. REMOVE REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
(a) Remove the clip and 4 joints shown in the
illustration, and then remove the rear door scuff
plate.
Clip
Joint
A083561E02
18. REMOVE FLOOR SIDE PANEL LH
(a) Remove the clip, then roll back the carpet.
Clip
A083560E01
(b) Remove the clip from the floor side panel.
(c) Remove the 3 bolts and floor side panel.
Clip
19. REMOVE NO. 6 BATTERY CARRIER PANEL (See
page HB-91)
20. REMOVE JUNCTION TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
A083595E01
21. REMOVE FRAME WIRE
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(a) Remove the 2 nuts, then remove the frame wire
from the No. 2 and No. 3 system main relay.
CAUTION:
Insulate the removed terminals with insulating
tape.
Frame Wire
A083533E02
HV
HV–558
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – FRAME WIRE
(b) Remove the clamps, then remove the frame wire
from the rear floor.
A083590E01
(c) Remove the 2 clamps, then disconnect the frame
wire from the center floor panel.
(d) Disconnect the connector.
(e) Disconnect the grommet.
Clamp
22. REMOVE WINDSHIELD WIPER ARM COVER
Grommet
Frame Wire
23. REMOVE FRONT WIPER ARM LH (See page WW-13)
24. REMOVE FRONT WIPER ARM RH (See page WW-13)
Connector
A083587E01
25. REMOVE HOOD TO COWL TOP SEAL (See page
WW-13)
26. REMOVE COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER LH (See
page WW-13)
27. REMOVE COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER RH (See
page WW-13)
28. REMOVE FRONT WIPER LINK AND WIPER MOTOR
ASSEMBLY (See page WW-13)
29. REMOVE FRONT COWL TOP PANEL OUTER (See
page FU-12)
HV
30. SEPARATE FRAME WIRE
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(a) Flip open the cover of the jump start terminal on the
engine room relay block.
Engine Room
Relay Block
A083592E01
(b) Remove the side cover by sliding it upward.
(c) Remove the nut, then disconnect the frame wire
from the engine room relay block.
(d) Disconnect the clamp, then disconnect the frame
wire from the side member.
Side Cover
: Clamp
A083585E02
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – FRAME WIRE
Clamp
Frame Wire
Connector
HV–559
(e) Remove the 2 frame wire connectors shown in the
illustration from the inverter with converter
assembly.
(f) Disconnect the clamp, then disconnect the frame
wire from the dash panel bracket.
31. REMOVE COLUMN HOLE COVER SILENCER SHEET
(See page SR-10)
32. SEPARATE STEERING INTERMEDIATE SHAFT (See
page SR-10)
33. REMOVE NO. 3 ENGINE UNDER COVER
34. REMOVE NO. 4 ENGINE UNDER COVER CENTER
(See page ET-3)
: Clamp
A083586E02
35. REMOVE FRONT FLOOR COVER LH
(a) Remove the 6 clips and front floor cover LH.
A083558E01
36. REMOVE FRONT FLOOR COVER CENTER LH
(a) Remove the 5 clips and front floor cover center LH.
HV
A083591E01
37. REMOVE NO. 1 WIRE HARNESS PROTECTOR
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(a) Remove the 2 nuts, bolt and wire harness protector.
A083589E01
HV–560
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – FRAME WIRE
38. SEPARATE FRONT SUSPENSION CROSSMEMBER
(a) Support the front suspension crossmember using a
jack.
A083583E01
(b) Remove the 4 bolts shown in the illustration from
the front suspension crossmember.
A083584E01
Clamp
HV
A083588E01
39. REMOVE FRAME WIRE
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(a) Remove the 2 bolts shown in the illustration.
(b) Disconnect the 2 clamps.
(c) Lower the jack a little and remove both nuts labeled
A.
NOTICE:
• Lower the jack slowly to avoid interfering
with objects loaded on the front suspension
crossmember.
• Do not remove the jack.
(d) Remove both nuts labeled B.
(e) Disconnect the fit-in clamps, then remove the frame
wire.
Fit-in Clamp
Fit-in Clamp
Frame Wire
Nut A
Nut B
Nut B
Clamp
A077534E04
HV–561
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – FRAME WIRE
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL FRAME WIRE
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(a) Temporarily fasten the frame wire to the vehicle.
(b) Connect the fit-in clamps to the stud in the floor
panel, and then install the frame wire with both nuts
labeled A.
Torque: 9.0 N*m (92 kgf*cm, 80 in.*lbf)
(c) Install both nuts labeled B shown in the illustration.
Torque: 9.0 N*m (92 kgf*cm, 80 in.*lbf)
Fit-in Clamp
Fit-in Clamp
Frame Wire
Nut A
Nut B
Nut B
Clamp
A077534E04
(d) As shown in the illustration, point the arrow on the
grommet in the front direction, then install the
grommet.
(e) Install the 2 bolts.
Torque: 9.0 N*m (92 kgf*cm, 80 in.*lbf)
(f) Install the 2 clamps.
Mark
Front Side
Grommet
Clamp
A077533E01
HV
HV–562
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – FRAME WIRE
2.
INSTALL FRONT SUSPENSION CROSSMEMBER
(a) Install the front suspension crossmember with the 4
bolts.
Torque: 113 N*m (1,152 kgf*cm, 83 in.*lbf) for
bolt A
157 N*m (1,601 kgf*cm, 116 in.*lbf) for
bolt B
(b) Remove the jack.
3.
INSTALL NO. 1 WIRE HARNESS PROTECTOR
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(a) Install the wire harness protector with the 2 bolts
and nut.
Torque: 9.0 N*m (92 kgf*cm, 80 in.*lbf)
4.
INSTALL FRONT FLOOR COVER CENTER LH
(a) Install the floor cover with the 5 clips.
5.
INSTALL FRONT FLOOR COVER LH
(a) Install the floor cover with the 6 clips.
6.
INSTALL NO. 3 ENGINE UNDER COVER
7.
INSTALL NO. 4 ENGINE UNDER COVER CENTER
8.
INSTALL STEERING INTERMEDIATE SHAFT (See
page EM-107)
9.
INSTALL COLUMN HOLE COVER SILENCER SHEET
A083584E01
A083589E01
HV
A083591E01
A083558E01
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – FRAME WIRE
Clamp
Frame Wire
Connector
: Clamp
HV–563
10. INSTALL FRAME WIRE
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(a) Connect the 2 connectors shown in the illustration to
the inverter with converter assembly.
(b) Connect the clamp to the engine room relay block
with the nut.
A083586E03
(c) Install the frame wire to the engine room relay block
with the nut.
Torque: 9.0 N*m (92 kgf*cm, 80 in.*lbf)
(d) Install the side cover to the engine room relay block.
(e) Install the frame wire clamp to the side member.
Side Cover
11. INSTALL FRONT COWL TOP PANEL OUTER (See
page FU-19)
: Clamp
A083585E03
12. INSTALL FRONT WIPER LINK AND WIPER MOTOR
ASSEMBLY (See page WW-16)
13. INSTALL COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER RH
14. INSTALL COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER LH
15. INSTALL HOOD TO COWL TOP SEAL
16. INSTALL FRONT WIPER ARM LH (See page WW-16)
17. INSTALL FRONT WIPER ARM RH (See page WW-16)
18. INSTALL FRONT WIPER ARM COVER
Clamp
Grommet
Frame Wire
Connector
A083587E01
19. INSTALL FRAME WIRE
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
(a) Connect the grommet.
(b) Connect the connector.
(c) Install the 2 clamps, then connect the frame wire to
the center floor panel.
HV
HV–564
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – FRAME WIRE
(d) Install the frame wire to the rear floor panel with the
clamp.
A083590E01
(e) Install the frame wire to the No. 2 and No. 3 system
main relay with 2 new nuts.
Torque: 5.6 N*m (57 kgf*cm, 50 in.*lbf)
20. INSTALL JUNCTION TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wear insulating gloves.
21. INSTALL NO. 6 BATTERY CARRIER PANEL (See
page HB-97)
A083533E01
22. INSTALL FLOOR SIDE PANEL LH
(a) Install the clip.
(b) Install the floor side panel with the 3 bolts.
Clip
HV
A083595E01
(c) Install the carpet with the clip.
23. INSTALL REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
24. INSTALL BATTERY CARRIER BRACKET (See page
HB-97)
Clip
25. INSTALL DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL LH (See page HB98)
26. INSTALL DECK FLOOR BOX LH (See page HB-98)
A083560E01
27. INSTALL REAR NO. 4 FLOOR BOARD (See page HB98)
28. INSTALL REAR SIDE SEATBACK FRAME LH (See
page HB-99)
29. INSTALL REAR NO. 1 FLOOR BOARD (See page HB99)
30. INSTALL REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY (See
page HB-99)
31. INSTALL TONNEAU COVER (See page HB-99)
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – FRAME WIRE
HV–565
32. INSTALL REAR DECK TRIM COVER (See page HB100)
33. INSTALL SERVICE PLUG GRIP (See page HB-154)
34. CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL (See page CH-7)
35. INSTALL REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
36. INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-8)
37. INSTALL REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
38. INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
39. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
HV
HV–566
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – ACCELERATOR PEDAL ROD
ACCELERATOR PEDAL ROD
HYBRID
P112
HYBRID
SYSTEM
VEHICLE CONTROL
COMPONENTS
HV
ACCELERATOR PEDAL POSITION
SENSOR CONNECTOR
ACCELERATOR PEDAL ROD
7.5 (77, 66 in.*lbf)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A117424E01
HV–567
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – ACCELERATOR PEDAL ROD
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT ACCELERATOR PEDAL ROD
NOTICE:
• Do not remove the accelerator pedal position
sensor from the accelerator pedal.
• Perform the inspection on the hybrid vehicle
control ECU side of the connector.
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Using a voltmeter, measure the voltage between the
terminals.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Hybrid Control ECU
Specified Condition
Normal
4.5 to 5.5 V
B-26 (VPA1) - B-27
(EP1)
Do not depress the
accelerator pedal
0.5 to 1.1 V
B-26 (VPA1) - B-27
(EP1)
Gradually depress the
accelerator pedal
The voltage increases
slowly
B-26 (VPA1) - B-27
(EP1)
Fully depress the
accelerator pedal
2.6 to 4.5 V
B-33 (VCP2) - B-35
(EP2)
Normal
4.5 to 5.5 V
B-34 (VPA2) - B-35
(EP2)
Do not depress the
accelerator pedal
1.2 to 2.0 V
B-34 (VPA2) - B-35
(EP2)
Gradually depress the
accelerator pedal
The voltage increases
slowly
B-34 (VPA2) - B-35
(EP2)
Fully depress the
accelerator pedal
3.4 to 5.3 V
EP2
EP1
VPA2
Connector D
Measuring Condition
B-25 (VCP) - B-27 (EP1)
Connector C
VPA1
VCP
HV
VCP2
Connector B
Connector A
A130645E02
If the standards are not met, replace the accelerator
pedal rod.
HV–568
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – ACCELERATOR PEDAL ROD
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
2.
REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-4)
3.
REMOVE REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
4.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
5.
REMOVE ACCELERATOR PEDAL ROD
(a) Disconnect the accelerator pedal position sensor
connector.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts, then remove the accelerator
pedal rod.
A087530E01
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL ACCELERATOR PEDAL ROD
(a) Install the accelerator pedal rod with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (77 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
(b) Connect the accelerator pedal position sensor
connector.
2.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL (See page CH-7)
3.
INSTALL REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
4.
INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-8)
5.
INSTALL REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
6.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
HV
A087530E01
HV–569
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL – IGCT RELAY
IGCT RELAY
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
Integration Relay
7K
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
INSPECT INTEGRATION RELAY (IGCT RELAY)
NOTICE:
IGCT relay is built into the integration relay.
7I
7J
A077561E03
(a) Check the resistance of the HEV fuse.
If the result is not as specified, replace the fuse.
(b) Measure the resistance of the IGCT relay.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
7J-1 - 7J-4
Specified Condition
10 kΩ or higher
7J-1 - 7K-4
Below 1 Ω
7J-2 - 7J-3
Below 1 Ω
7J-4 - 7K-1
10 kΩ or higher
7J-1 - 7J-4
Below 1 Ω (when battery voltage is
applied to terminals 7J-2 and 7J-3)
7J-1 - 7K-1
Below 1 Ω (when battery voltage is
applied to terminals 7J-2 and 7J-3)
If the standards are not met, replace the integration
relay.
HV
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID TRANSAXLE SYSTEM
HX–1
HYBRID TRANSAXLE SYSTEM
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
(a) Remove the filler plug.
(b) Ensure that the transaxle oil level is within 0 to 5
mm (0 to 0.20 in.) of the filler plug hole.
NOTICE:
Recheck the transaxle oil level after driving the
vehicle when exchanging oil.
HINT:
Transaxle fluid quantity: 3.8 liters (4.0 US qts, 3.3
Imp. qts.)
(c) Check for leaks if the quantity of oil is low.
(d) Install the filler plug with a new gasket.
Torque: 39 N*m (400 kgf*cm, 29 ft.*lbf)
Filler Plug
Drain Plug
G030993E01
2.
SST
SST
G030394E01
CHECK TRANSAXLE FLUID LEVEL
NOTICE:
• Insufficient or excessive amounts of transaxle oil
may be the cause of some trouble.
• Place the vehicle on level surface.
• Use genuine ATF WS.
INSPECT OIL PRESSURE
NOTICE:
Perform the test at normal operating oil temperature
50 to 80°C (122 to 176°F).
(a) Lift up the vehicle.
(b) Remove the fluid pump cover plug and install SST.
SST 09992-00095 (09992-00112, 09992-00271)
(c) Set the blower switch to HI.
(d) Turn the A/C switch on.
(e) Push the power switch with the brake pedal
depressed to start the engine (start the hybrid
system).
(f) Keeping the engine speed of 1,200 rpm, measure
the oil pressure.
Standard oil pressure:
9.8 kPa (0.1 kgf/cm2, 1.4 psi) or more
(g) Install a new O-ring and fluid pump cover plug.
Torque: 7.4 N*m (75 kgf*cm, 65 in.*lbf)
G030396E01
HX
HX–2
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID TRANSAXLE SYSTEM
3.
Key Slot
INSPECT SHIFT LEVER
(a) Inspect the shift lever operation with the hybrid
system operating.
(1) Carry the key into the indoor electrical key
oscillator detection area or insert the key in the
key slot.
(2) Turn the power switch ON (READY ON) while
depressing the brake pedal.
Check that the gear changes according to the
shift operation pattern. If the check result is
abnormal, replace the shift lever assembly.
HINT:
The shift operation pattern in power switch ON
(READY ON) (when the vehicle is stopped) is
shown below.
Turn the power switch ON
C097702E02
Power Mode
Operation
P
R
N
D
B
Shift Lever Operation
Hybrid System in operation
(driving possible)
HX
P Position Switch Operation
C130921E01
(b) Turn the power switch OFF when the vehicle is
stopped.
Power Switch
G021872E01
HX–3
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID TRANSAXLE SYSTEM
(c) Inspect the shift lever operation with the power
switch's power mode ON (IG).
(1) Carry the key into the indoor electrical key
oscillator detection area or insert the key in the
key slot.
Key Slot
G030999E01
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG) without depressing
the brake pedal.
HINT:
The power switch's power mode changes between
OFF, ON (ACC) and ON (IG) each time the power
switch is pressed.
(e) Check that the gear changes according to the shift
operation pattern. If the check result is not as
specified, replace the shift lever assembly.
HINT:
The shift operation pattern with the power switch's
power mode ON (IG) is shown below.
Power Switch
Turn the power switch ON without
depressing the brake pedal.
G030998E02
Power Mode
Power switch ON (IG)
(Driving not possible)
Operation
HX
P
R
N
D
B
Shift Lever Operation
P Position Switch Operation
C130922E01
HX–4
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER
SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
1.
NOTICE FOR INITIALIZATION
When the cable of the negative (-) battery terminal is
disconnected, initialize the following systems after the
cable is reconnected.
System Name
See procedure
Power Window Control System
IN-32
2. NOTICE FOR HYBRID SYSTEM ACTIVATION
• When the warning light is illuminated or the battery has
been disconnected and reconnected, pressing the power
switch may not start the system on the first try. If so, press
the power switch again.
• With the power switch's power mode changed to ON (IG),
disconnect the battery. If the key is not in the key slot
during reconnection, DTC B2799 may be output.
HX
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
HX–5
PARTS LOCATION
P POSITION SWITCH
(P POSITION SWITCH INDICATOR LIGHT)
COMBINATION METER
- MASTER WARNING LIGHT
MULTI-DISPLAY
HYBRID VEHICLE
CONTROL ECU
POWER SOURCE
CONTROL ECU
TRANSMISSION
CONTROL ECU
ENGINE ROOM RELAY BLOCK
AND JUNCTION BLOCK
- TRANSAXLE PARKING LOCK
CONTROL RELAY
(Marking: P CON)
- INTEGRATION RELAY
(unit B: IGCT RELAY)
- P CON MTR H-FUSE
- P CON MAIN FUSE
- HEV FUSE
DLC3
SELECTOR LEVER
HYBRID VEHICLE
TRANSAXLE
HX
SHIFT CONTROL ACTUATOR
C126757E01
HX–6
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
: BEAN
Selector Lever
: CAN
Multi-display
P Position Switch
: AVC-LAN
Skid Control ECU
P Position Switch
Hybrid Vehicle
Control ECU
Indicator Light
Gateway ECU
Vehicle Information
- Vehicle Speed Signal
- Stop Light Switch Signal
Power Source
Control ECU
Skid Control Actuator
HX
Parking Lock Motor
Transmission Control ECU
Rotation Angle Sensor
Combination Meter
Transponder Key ECU
Certification ECU
Multiplex Network Body ECU
C126758E01
Input and output signals of each ECU
Transmitting ECU (transmitter)
Receiving ECU
Signals
Communication method
Skid Control ECU
Transmission Control ECU
PKB switch signal
CAN, BEAN
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
Transmitting ECU (transmitter)
Receiving ECU
Signals
Communication method
Power Source Control ECU
Transmission Control ECU
Power off preparation signal
BEAN
Main Body ECU
Transmission Control ECU
•
•
Power switch signal
ACC switch signal
BEAN
Transmission Control ECU
Power Source Control ECU
•
•
P position state signal
Transmission control ECU
trouble condition signal
Auto P cancel signal
Non-P position state signal
Auto P permit signal
BEAN
•
•
•
Transmission Control ECU
Multi-display
Transmission control ECU trouble
signal
AVC-LAN, BEAN
Transmission Control ECU
Combination Meter
Transmission control ECU trouble
signal
BEAN
Transmission Control ECU
Transponder Key Amplifier
•
•
BEAN
Transmission Control ECU
Certification ECU
P position state signal
P position state signal
Key condition signal
HX–7
BEAN
HX
HX–8
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
2.
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The electronic shift lever system electrically controls the
parking lock mechanism by using the actuator.
The transmission control ECU controls the shift control
actuator, and also controls the entire system based on
information from the hybrid vehicle control ECU.
The transmission control ECU detects DTCs when there
are any malfunctions in the system, and informs the
driver of the malfunction by illuminating the P position
switch indicator light and master warning light, and
indicating an error message on the multi-display.
FUNCTION OF EACH COMPONENT
Parts name
Function
Shift Control Actuator
•
•
•
Transmission Control ECU
•
•
HX
Composed of the parking lock motor and the rotation angle
sensor. The motor is activated by electric current from the
transmission control ECU.
Motor rotation is reduced by the cycloid reduction mechanism in
the shift control actuator and then output.
The rotation angle sensor detects the motor rotation angle with the
3 Hall ICs.
This ECU activates the shift control actuator based on signals
from the hybrid vehicle control ECU and the power source control
ECU.
This ECU controls the application timing of current to the parking
lock motor based on signals from the rotation angle sensor.
Parking Lock Mechanism
The parking lock pawl rotates according to the movement of the
parking lock rod when the parking lock motor rotates, and engages
with the parking gear on the transaxle side, causing the parking lock
mechanism to lock or unlock.
Hybrid Vehicle Control ECU
This ECU sends a P lock or P unlock demand signal to the
transmission control ECU based on information from the selector lever
and the P position switch.
Power Source Control ECU
This ECU sends a signal with power off information to the
transmission control ECU. The transmission control ECU then sends
the signal to the hybrid vehicle control ECU.
P Position Switch Indicator Light
This light comes on/goes off to indicate the P lock/unlock status and
blinks to indicate a malfunction in the electronic shift lever system.
Combination Meter
A malfunction in the transmission control ECU is indicated by the
illumination of the master warning light on the combination meter.
Multi-display
A malfunction in the transmission control ECU is indicated on the
multi-display.
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
3.
P Position Switch “ON”
Switch Operation Signal
HX–9
OPERATION DESCRIPTION
(a) Operation to switch to the P position:
(1) When the P position switch is turned on to
activate parking lock, a signal is sent to the
hybrid vehicle control ECU.
(2) The hybrid vehicle control ECU determines
whether "P lock" is possible or not based on this
signal and other vehicle information.
(3) If the hybrid vehicle control ECU determines that
"P lock" is possible, it sends a "P lock" operation
demand signal to the transmission control ECU.
Transmission
Control ECU
“P Lock” Operation
Signal
Hybrid Vehicle
Control ECU
Vehicle Speed
Signal
C126759E01
HX
HX–10
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
P Position Switch
Indicator Light
(4) After receiving the signal, the transmission
control ECU activates the shift control actuator in
order to lock the parking lock mechanism, and
turns on the P position switch indicator light.
ON Demand Signal
Skid Control
Actuator
“P Lock”
Switch
Control
Rotation Angle
Sensor Signal
Transmission
Control ECU
C126760E01
HX
Cycloid Reduction Mechanism
Output Shaft
Internal Gear
External Gear
Center of
Eccentric
Adapter
Bearing
Eccentric
Adapter
Center of Motor
Input Shaft
C126761E01
(5) The transmission control ECU controls motor
rotation angle based on signals from the rotation
angle sensor in the shift control actuator.
HINT:
In the cycloid reduction mechanism, the output
shaft is linked to the external gear. Together,
they rotate only a single tooth when the
eccentric adapter, which is linked to the motor,
rotates once. Driving force is increased in this
way so that the parking lock mechanism can be
switched even when high output is required for
parking on a hill, etc.
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
HX–11
(b) Operation to switch to a non-P position:
(1) When the hybrid system is started (the vehicle is
ready to be driven) and the selector lever is
moved to the R, N, or the D position with the
brake pedal depressed, a signal is sent to the
hybrid vehicle control ECU.
(2) This signal is then sent from the hybrid vehicle
control ECU to the transmission control ECU as
a "P lock release" operation demand signal.
Selector Lever
Selector Lever
Operation Signal
Transmission
Control ECU
“P Lock Release”
Operation Signal
Hybrid Vehicle
Control ECU
Stop Light
Switch Signal
C126762E01
HX
HX–12
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
P Position Switch
Indicator Light
OFF Demand Signal
Shift Control
Actuator
“P Lock
Release”
Switch Control
Rotation Angle
Sensor Signal
Transmission
Control ECU
C126763E01
HX
4.
(3) After receiving the signal, the transmission
control ECU activates the shift control actuator in
order to unlock the parking lock mechanism, and
turns off the P position switch indicator light.
(4) The transmission control ECU controls motor
rotation angle based on signals from the rotation
angle sensor in the shift control actuator.
SHIFT POSITION CHANGE FUNCTION
(a) The electronic shift lever system comprehensively
determines vehicle conditions and changes the shift
position, as shown in the following chart, by
cooperating with the shift control function of the
hybrid system (except when the reject function,
described later, is in operation).
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
HX–13
(b) Other than indicated in the following chart, when the
power switch is turned OFF with the vehicle
stopped, the shift position is automatically changed
to the P position.
Power Status
ON (ACC)*
(The vehicle cannot be driven.)
Operation
Selector lever operation
Unable to change the shift position
P position switch operation
ON (IG)*
(The vehicle cannot be driven.)
Selector lever operation
P position switch operation
Selector lever operation
The hybrid system is started.
(The vehicle can be driven.)
HX
P position switch operation
*: The vehicle cannot be driven because the
hybrid system has not been started.
: Current position
: Positions to which the shift
position can be changed
C126764E01
HX–14
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
5.
HX
REJECT FUNCTION
(a) In the electronic shift lever system, there may be a
situation in which a shift change cannot be done for
safety reasons. When attempting to move the
selector lever in such a situation, the system sounds
a reject buzzer inside the meter and changes the
shift position as shown in the following table.
Shift operation which causes reject function to operate
Shift position after rejection
Shifting from the P position without depressing the brake pedal
Held in the P position
Shifting to the P position while driving
Changed to the N position
Shifting between forward and reverse positions while driving
Changed to the N position
Shifting to the B position from the position other than D
Changed to the N position
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
HX–15
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
• Use these procedures to troubleshoot the electronic shift
lever system.
• *: Use the intelligent tester.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
INSPECT BATTERY VOLTAGE
Standard voltage:
11 to 14 V
If the voltage is below 11 V, recharge or replace the battery
before proceeding.
NEXT
3
CHECK COMMUNICATION FUNCTION OF MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
(BEAN)*
(a) Use the intelligent tester to check if the Multiplex
Communication System (MPX) is functioning normally.
Result
Result
Proceed to
MPX DTC is not output
A
MPX DTC is output
B
B
Go to MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION
SYSTEM
A
4
CHECK COMMUNICATION FUNCTION OF CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM*
(a) Use the intelligent tester to check if the CAN
communication system is functioning normally.
Result
Result
Proceed to
CAN DTC is not output
A
CAN DTC is output
B
B
A
Go to CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
HX
HX–16
5
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
CHECK FOR DTC*
(a) Check for DTCs and note any codes that are output.
(b) Delete the DTC.
(c) Recheck for DTCs. Based on the DTCs output above, try
to force output of the electronic shift lever system DTC
by simulating the operation indicated by the DTC.
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC is not output
A
DTC is output
B
B
Go to step 8
A
6
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Refer to the problem symptoms table (see page HX-15).
Result
Result
Proceed to
Fault is not listed in problem symptoms table
A
Fault is listed in problem symptoms table
B
B
Go to step 8
A
7
OVERALL ANALYSIS AND TROUBLESHOOTING*
(a) DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST (see page HX-19)
(b) Terminals of ECU (see page HX-15)
HX
NEXT
8
NEXT
END
REPAIR OR REPLACE
HX–17
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
• Use the table below to help determine the cause of the
problem symptom. The potential causes of the symptoms
are listed in order of probability in the "Suspected area"
column of the table. Check each symptom by checking the
suspected areas in the order they are listed. Replace parts
as necessary.
• Inspect the fuses and relays related to this system before
inspecting the suspected areas below.
Electronic shift lever system
Symptom
P position switch indicator light does not come on.
P position switch indicator light does not go off.
Suspected area
See page
1. P position switch indicator light circuit
HX-54
2. Transmission control ECU
HX-15
1. P position switch indicator light circuit
HX-54
2. Transmission control ECU
HX-15
HX
HX–18
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
CHECK TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU
HINT:
Inspect the connectors from the back side while the
connector is connected.
T4
12
11
10
9 8 7 6 5 4
26 25 24 23 22 21 20
3
2
1
19 18 17 16 15 14 13
B119765E02
HX
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
+B (T4-1) - E1 (T4-15)
L - W-B
Power source
Power switch ON (IG)
9 to 14 V
E02 (T4-2) - Body ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 V
E01 (T4-3) - Body ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 V
RZ1 (T4-4) - E2 (T4-16)
L-P
Rotation angle sensor
signal
Power switch ON (IG)
4 to 5.5 V
RB (T4-5) - E2 (T4-16)
GR - P
Rotation angle sensor
signal
Power switch ON (IG)
4 to 5.5 V
RA (T4-6) - E2 (T4-16)
LG - P
Rotation angle sensor
signal
Power switch ON (IG)
4 to 5.5 V
PCON (T4-7) - E1 (T4-15)
LG - W-B
Communication bus
Power switch ON (IG)
Pulse generation
(see wave form 1)
PPOS (T4-8) - E1 (T4-15)
W - W-B
Communication bus
Power switch ON (IG)
Pulse generation
(see wave form 2)
IND (T4-9) - E1 (T4-15)
R - W-B
P position switch indicator
light
P position switch ON
Below 1 V
MWA (T4-10) - E1 (T4-15)
W - W-B
Parking lock motor
Power switch ON (IG)
9 to 14 V
MVA (T4-11) - E1 (T4-15)
R - W-B
Parking lock motor
Power switch ON (IG)
9 to 14 V
MUA (T4-12) - E1 (T4-15)
B - W-B
Parking lock motor
Power switch ON (IG)
9 to 14 V
BATT (T4-13) - E1 (T4-15)
L - W-B
Power source (RAM)
Always
9 to 14 V
BMA (T4-14) - E1 (T4-15)
B - W-B
P CON relay
Power switch ON (IG)
9 to 14 V
E1 (T4-15) - Body ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 V
E2 (T4-16) - Body ground
P - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 V
VC (T4-17) - E2 (T4-16)
O-P
Power source (Rotation
angle sensor)
Power switch ON (IG)
4 to 5.5 V
MPX2 (T4-18) - E1 (T415)
B - W-B
Multiplex communication
Power switch OFF
Power switch ON (IG)
Below 1 V
Pulse generation
MPX1 (T4-19) - E1 (T415)
GR - W-B
Multiplex communication
Power switch OFF
Power switch ON (IG)
Below 1 V
Pulse generation
SIL (T4-20) - E1 (T4-15)
W - W-B
Diagnosis tester
communication
Power switch ON (IG)
8 V or higher
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
HX–19
(a) Using an oscilloscope, check the waveform 1.
Waveform 1 (Reference)
Waveform 1
Item
Content
Symbols (Terminal No.)
P CON (T4-7) - E1 (T4-15)
Tool setting
5 V/DIV., 20 msec./DIV.
Condition
Power switch ON (IG)
GND
C126766E01
(b) Using an oscilloscope, check the waveform 2.
Waveform 2 (Reference)
Waveform 2
Item
Content
Symbols (Terminal No.)
PPOS (T4-8) - E1 (T4-15)
Tool setting
5 V/DIV., 20 msec./DIV.
Condition
Power switch ON (IG)
GND
C126767E01
HX
HX–20
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
SG
CG
1.
DESCRIPTION
(a) Electronic shift lever system data and the Diagnostic
Trouble Codes (DTCs) can be read in the Data Link
Connector 3 (DLC3) of the vehicle. When the
system seems to be malfunctioning, use the
intelligent tester to check for malfunctions and
perform repairs.
2.
CHECK DLC3
The vehicle uses ISO 15765-4 communication protocol.
The terminal arrangement of the DLC3 complies with
SAE J1962 and matches the ISO 15765-4 format.
CANH
SIL
BAT
CANL
H100769E19
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
SIL (7) - SG (5)
Bus "+" line
During transmission
Pulse generation
CG (4) - Body ground
Chassis ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
SG (5) - Body ground
Signal ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
BAT (16) - Body ground
Battery positive
Always
11 to 14 V
CANH (6) - CANL (14)
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Power Switch OFF*
54 to 69 Ω
CANH (6) - Battery positive (+)
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Power Switch OFF*
1 MΩ or higher
CANH (6) - CG (4)
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Power Switch OFF*
1 kΩ or higher
CANL (14) - Battery positive (+)
LOW-level CAN bus line
Power Switch OFF*
1 MΩ or higher
CANL (14) - CG (4)
LOW-level CAN bus line
Power Switch OFF*
1 kΩ or higher
NOTICE:
*: Before measuring the resistance, leave the vehicle
as is for at least 1 minute and do not operate the
power switch, any other switches or the doors.
If the result is not as specified, the DLC3 may have a
malfunction. Repair or replace the harness and
connector.
HINT:
Connect the cable of the intelligent tester (with CAN
VIM) to the DLC3, turn the power switch ON (IG) and
attempt to use the tester. If the displays indicators that a
communication error has occurred, there is a problem
either with the vehicle or with the tester.
• If communication is normal when the tester is
connected to another vehicle, inspect the DLC3 of the
original vehicle.
• If communication is still not possible when the tester
is connected to another vehicle, the problem may be
in the tester itself. Consult the Service Department
listed in the tester's instruction manual.
HX
Intelligent
Tester
DLC3
CAN VIM
A082795E09
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
HX–21
DTC CHECK / CLEAR
1.
Intelligent
Tester
DLC3
2.
CAN VIM
A082795E09
CHECK DTC
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Read the DTC by following the prompts on the
tester screen.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual for
further details.
CLEAR DTC
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Erase the DTC by following the directions on the
tester screen.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual for
further details.
HX
HX–22
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
FREEZE FRAME DATA
1.
HX
CHECK FREEZE FRAME DATA
(a) The vehicle status, stored during system operation
or at the time of an error code detection, can be
displayed by the intelligent tester.
(b) Only one record of freeze frame data is stored and
the freeze frame data generated during system
operation are updated whenever the vehicle status
is changed. After storing the DTC, the freeze frame
data is not updated.
Tester Display
Measurement Item
Reference Value
SHFT POS P
Shift position display (P)
ON or OFF
SHFT POS N-P
Shift position display (not P)
ON or OFF
MAS CAUTION
Master caution display
DISP or NONDISP
PSW INDICATOR
PSW indicator mode
OFF, ON, FAST, or SLOW
U VOL VAL
U phase voltage value
min: 0 V, max: 20 V
V VOL VAL
V phase voltage value
min: 0 V, max: 20 V
W VOL VAL
W phase voltage value
min: 0 V, max: 20 V
BATT VOL VAL
BATT voltage value
min: 0 V, max: 20 V
IG (+B) VOL VAL
IG (+B) voltage value
min: 0 V, max: 20 V
P SPLY OFF SIG
Power supply off preparation request signal
ON or OFF
LRN LOCK POS
Completion of learning lock position
OK or NG
LRN UNLOCK POS
Completion of learning unlock position
OK or NG
TRIP CNTR
Number of trip counter after learning
min: 0, max: 65535
MTR MAIN RELAY
Main relay for motor drive
ON or OFF
ELCTRCL KEY SIG
Signal of electrical key condition
ON or OFF
CURRENT U
U phase current-carrying status
ON or OFF
CURRENT V
V phase current-carrying status
ON or OFF
CURRENT W
W phase current-carrying status
ON or OFF
U VOL
U phase voltage status
ON or OFF
V VOL
V phase voltage status
ON or OFF
W VOL
W phase voltage status
ON or OFF
BATT VOL
BATT voltage status
ON or OFF
IG VOL
IG (+B) phase voltage status
ON or OFF
ACC SIG
ACC condition signal
ON or OFF
INIT CNTRL
Initial drive control completed
OK or NG
DTCT LOCK POS
Completion of detecting lock position
OK or NG
DTCT UNLOCK POS
Completion of detecting unlock position
OK or NG
SHFT RANGE
P/Not P movable shift range
SET or UNSET
MAIN RELAY
Main relay
NORMAL or ABNOML
VHCL COND
Vehicle condition
STOP or MOVE
FAIL RANK
Fail rank
min: 0, max: 255
ECU TYPE
Type of ECU
min: 0, max: 65535
DETAIL INFO1
Detailed information 1
Failure information is displayed in
hexadecimal
DETAIL INFO2
Detailed information 2
Failure information is displayed in
hexadecimal
DETAIL INFO3
Detailed information 3
Failure information is displayed in
hexadecimal
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
HX–23
FAIL-SAFE CHART
If the transmission control ECU detects a malfunction, the failsafe functions shown in the table below are activated.
DTC No.
Fail-safe Function
Problem Symptoms
C2300
C2301
Only the P position release operation is
possible and the shift control actuator is
activated.
•
C2303
-
The battery is dead.
C2304
C2305
C2306
The transaxle parking lock control relay is
turned off.
The parking lock mechanism cannot be
switched.
C2307
The transaxle parking lock control relay is
turned off.
•
•
•
The shift position is not indicated on the
meter.
Although the shift position is indicated on
the meter, the vehicle cannot be driven.
The shift position is not indicated on the
meter.
Although the shift position is indicated on
the meter, the vehicle cannot be driven.
C2311
-
The parking lock mechanism cannot be
switched.
C2312
-
The hybrid system does not start up.
C2318
-
The parking lock mechanism cannot be
switched on a hill.
HX
HX–24
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST
1.
READ DATA LIST
HINT:
Using the intelligent tester's DATA LIST allows switch,
sensor, actuator and other item values to be read without
removing any parts. Reading the DATA LIST early in
troubleshooting is one way to save time.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and press the
intelligent tester main switch on.
(c) Read the DATA LIST by following the directions on
the tester screen.
Transmission control ECU
HX
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
SHFT POS P
Shift position display (P) / ON or
OFF
ON: Parking lock is in P position
OFF: Parking lock is in non-P
position
-
SHFT POS N-P
Shift position display (not P) / ON
or OFF
ON: Parking lock is in non-P
position
OFF: Parking lock is in P position
-
MAS CAUTION
Master caution display / DISP or
NONDISP
DISP: Malfunction occurs in this
system
NONDISP: Malfunction does not
occur in this system
-
PSW INDICATOR
PSW indicator mode / OFF, ON,
FAST, or SLOW
OFF: Parking lock is in non-P
position
ON: Parking lock is in P position
FAST: Actuator takes long time to
switch between the P position and
non-P position
SLOW: Malfunction occurs in this
system
-
U VOL VAL
U phase voltage value / min: 0 V,
max: 20 V
Actual U phase voltage 9 to 14 V
-
V VOL VAL
V phase voltage value / min: 0 V,
max: 20 V
Actual V phase voltage 9 to 14 V
-
W VOL VAL
W phase voltage value / min: 0 V,
max: 20 V
Actual W phase voltage 9 to 14 V
-
BATT VOL VAL
BATT voltage value / min: 0 V,
max: 20 V
Actual power supply voltage 9 to
14 V
-
IG (+B) VOL VAL
IG (+B) voltage value / min: 0 V,
max: 20 V
Actual power supply voltage 9 to
14 V
-
P SPLY OFF SIG
Power supply off preparation
request signal / ON or OFF
ON: Power is turned off by power
source control ECU after
receiving power switch OFF
signal
OFF: Any other condition
-
LRN LOCK POS
Completion of learning lock
position / OK or NG
OK: Lock position learning is
complete
NG: Lock position learning is not
complete
-
LRN UNLOCK POS
Completion of learning unlock
position / OK or NG
OK: Unlock position learning is
complete
NG: Unlock position learning is
not complete
-
TRIP CNTR
Number of trip counter after
learning / min: 0, max: 65535
Actual number of trip counter
Reset the trip counter after 1,000
times
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
MTR MAIN RELAY
Main relay for motor drive / ON or
OFF
ON: Motor drive main relay on
OFF: Motor drive main relay off
-
ELCTRCL KEY SIG
Signal of electrical key condition /
ON or OFF
ON: Electrical key is recognized
OFF: Electrical key is not
recognized
-
#CODE
Number of diagnosis code / min:
0, max: 255
Actual number of diagnosis code
-
CURRENT U
U phase current-carrying status /
ON or OFF
ON: U phase current flows
OFF: U phase current does not
flow
-
CURRENT V
V phase current-carrying status /
ON or OFF
ON: V phase current flows
OFF: V phase current does not
flow
-
CURRENT W
W phase current-carrying status /
ON or OFF
ON: W phase current flows
OFF: W phase current does not
flow
-
U VOL
U phase voltage status / ON or
OFF
ON: U phase voltage is 6 V or
more
OFF: U phase voltage is less than
6V
-
V VOL
V phase voltage status / ON or
OFF
ON: V phase voltage is 6 V or
more
OFF: V phase voltage is less than
6V
-
W VOL
W phase voltage status / ON or
OFF
ON: W phase voltage is 6 V or
more
OFF: W phase voltage is less
than 6 V
-
BATT VOL
BATT voltage status / ON or OFF
ON: BATT voltage is more than
10 V
OFF: BATT voltage is 10 V or less
-
IG VOL
IG (+B) phase voltage status / ON
or OFF
ON: +B voltage is more than 10 V
OFF: +B voltage is 10 V or less
-
ACC SIG
ACC condition signal / ON or OFF
ON: ACC condition signal is
normal
OFF: ACC condition signal is
interrupted
-
INIT CNTRL
Initial drive control completed /
OK or NG
OK: Initial drive control is
complete
NG: Initial drive control is not
complete
-
DTCT LOCK POS
Completion of detecting lock
position / OK or NG
OK: Detection of lock position is
complete
NG: Detection of lock position is
not complete
-
DTCT UNLOCK POS
Completion of detecting unlock
position / OK or NG
OK: Detection of unlock position
is complete
NG: Detection of unlock position
is not complete
-
SHFT RANGE
P/Not P movable shift range /
SET or UNSET
SET: P/Not P movable shift range
is set
UNSET: P/Not P movable shift
range is unset
-
MAIN RELAY
Main relay / NORMAL or
ABNOML
NORMAL: Main relay is normal
ABNOML: Main relay is fault
-
VHCL COND
Vehicle condition / STOP or
MOVE
STOP: Vehicle is stopped
MOVE: Vehicle is running
-
ECU TYPE
Type of ECU / min: 0, max: 65535
Actual type of ECU
-
HX–25
HX
HX–26
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
If a trouble code is displayed during the DTC check, check
the circuit listed for that code in the table below and proceed
to the appropriate page.
HINT:
• When the DTC C2300, C2301, C2304, C2305, C2306,
C2307, C2311 and C2312 are detected, DTC P3102
indicating the electronic shift lever system malfunctions
are detected for the hybrid system as well. Because of
this, the hybrid system DTCs must be cleared after
clearing the electronic shift lever system DTCs.
• Remove the P CON MAIN fuse to erase DTCs C2300,
C2301, C2303, C2304, C2305, C2306 and C2307
because they cannot be erased with the intelligent tester.
• When a DTC is detected, the master warning light comes
on and an error message is indicated on the multi-display.
• The indicator blinks quickly when it takes a long time to
switch between the P position status and the P position
release status.
DTC No.
HX
Detection Item
Trouble Area
P Position Switch
Indicator Light
Condition
HINT
See page
C2300
ACT System
Malfunction
- Shift control
actuator
- Transaxle parking
lock control relay
- Transmission
control ECU
- Wire harness or
connector
Blinks slowly
If DTC C2318 is
output
simultaneously,
perform
troubleshooting for
DTC C2318 first.
HX-24
C2301
Shift Changing Time
Malfunction
- Shift control
actuator
- Transmission
control ECU
Blinks slowly
If DTC C2318 is
output
simultaneously,
perform
troubleshooting for
DTC C2318 first.
HX-31
C2303
Relay Malfunction
(+B Short)
- Transaxle parking
lock control relay
- Transmission
control ECU
- Wire harness or
connector
Normal
- P position status:
the P position switch
indicator light is on.
- P position release
status: the P position
switch indicator light
is off.
If DTC C2318 is
output
simultaneously,
perform
troubleshooting for
DTC C2318 first.
HX-32
C2304
Open or Short Circuit
in "U" Phase
- Shift control
actuator
- Transmission
control ECU
- Transaxle parking
lock control relay
- Wire harness or
connector
Blinks slowly
If DTC C2318 is
output
simultaneously,
perform
troubleshooting for
DTC C2318 first.
HX-35
C2305
Open or Short Circuit
in "V" Phase
- Shift control
actuator
- Transmission
control ECU
- Transaxle parking
lock control relay
- Wire harness or
connector
Blinks slowly
If DTC C2318 is
output
simultaneously,
perform
troubleshooting for
DTC C2318 first.
HX-35
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
HINT
P Position Switch
Indicator Light
Condition
See page
DTC No.
Detection Item
C2306
Open or Short Circuit
in "W" Phase
- Shift control
actuator
- Transmission
control ECU
- Transaxle parking
lock control relay
- Wire harness or
connector
Blinks slowly
If DTC C2318 is
output
simultaneously,
perform
troubleshooting for
DTC C2318 first.
HX-35
C2307
Power Source
Malfunction
- Transmission
control ECU
- Wire harness or
connector
- Parking lock motor
(Shift control
actuator)
Blinks slowly
If DTC C2318 is
output
simultaneously,
perform
troubleshooting for
DTC C2318 first.
HX-40
C2310
Open or Short Circuit
in BATT
- P CON MAIN fuse
- Transmission
control ECU
- Wire harness or
connector
Normal
- P position status:
the P position switch
indicator light is on.
- P position release
status: the P position
switch indicator light
is off.
-
HX-42
C2311
HV Communication
Line Malfunction
- Transmission
control ECU
- Hybrid vehicle
control ECU
- Wire harness or
connector
Blinks slowly
-
HX-44
C2312
Power Source
Control ECU
Communication Line
Malfunction
- Transmission
control ECU
- Power source
control ECU
Normal
- P position status:
the P position switch
indicator light is on.
- P position release
status: the P position
switch indicator light
is off.
-
HX-47
C2315
HV System
Malfunction
- Hybrid vehicle
control ECU
- P position switch
- Transmission
control ECU
- Wire harness or
connector
Normal
- P position status:
the P position switch
indicator light is on.
- P position release
status: the P position
switch indicator light
is off.
-
HX-50
Low Voltage Error
(Power Supply
Malfunction)
- HEV fuse
- IGCT relay
- Wire harness or
connector
- Auxiliary battery
Normal
- P position status:
the P position switch
indicator light is on.
- P position release
status: the P position
switch indicator light
is off.
-
C2318
Trouble Area
HX–27
HX
HX-52
HX–28
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
DTC
C2300
ACT System Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The shift control actuator consists of the parking lock motor and the rotation angle sensor. The
transmission control ECU receives a P position switch signal from the hybrid vehicle control ECU and
activates the parking lock motor by controlling current, causing the parking lock mechanism to switch. The
transmission control ECU also detects the rotor rotation angle through the rotation angle sensor to control
timing of current application to the coils. The transmission control ECU outputs this DTC when it detects a
malfunction in the shift control actuator system.
HX
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C2300
When both conditions below are met:
• Power switch ON (IG).
• There is an open or short circuit in the
transaxle parking lock control relay and/or
shift control actuator, or an internal
abnormality in the shift control actuator.
•
•
•
•
Shift control actuator
Transaxle parking lock control relay (P
CON Relay)
Transmission control ECU
Wire harness or connector
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
HX–29
WIRING DIAGRAM
Shift Control Actuator Assembly
Transmission Control ECU
RE2
E2
RZ1
RZ1
RB
RB
RA
RA
RVC
VC
MWA
MWA
V Phase
MVA
MVA
W Phase
U Phase
MGNA
MUA
MUA
P CON
P CON MTR
HX
BMA
E02
MAIN
Auxiliary Battery
E01
C126768E01
HX–30
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK OTHER DTC OUTPUT (BESIDES DTC C2300)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Turn the intelligent tester on.
(d) Read the DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC output)
Proceed to
No output
A
C2304, C2305, C2306 and C2318
B
HINT:
If any other codes besides C2300 are output, perform
the troubleshooting for those DTCs first.
B
REPAIR CIRCUIT INDICATED BY OUTPUT
CODE
A
2
CHECK TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU (VC, RA, RB, RZ1 VOLTAGE)
RA
RB
(a) Measure the voltage of the ECU connector.
Standard voltage
RZ1
Tester Connection
T4
E2
HX
VC
F044944E02
NG
Condition
Specified Condition
T4-4 (RZ1) - T4-16 (E2)
Power switch ON (IG)
4 to 5.5 V
T4-5 (RB) - T4-16 (E2)
Power switch ON (IG)
4 to 5.5 V
T4-6 (RA) - T4-16 (E2)
Power switch ON (IG)
4 to 5.5 V
T4-17 (VC) - T4-16 (E2)
Power switch ON (IG)
4 to 5.5 V
OK
Go to step 5
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
3
HX–31
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU - SHIFT CONTROL
ACTUATOR)
(a) Disconnect the T4 ECU connector.
(b) Disconnect the S1 actuator connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Transmission Control ECU
RZ1 RB RA
T4
E2
VC
Shift Control Actuator
RB
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T4-17 (VC) - S1-9 (RVC)
Below 1 Ω
T4-5 (RB) - S1-3 (RB)
Below 1 Ω
T4-6 (RA) - S1-5 (RA)
Below 1 Ω
T4-4 (RZ1) - S1-4 (RZ1)
Below 1 Ω
T4-16 (E2) - S1-8 (RE2)
Below 1 Ω
T4-4 (RZ1) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
T4-5 (RB) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
T4-6 (RA) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
T4-17 (VC) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
RZ1
RA
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
S1
RE2
RVC
C126765E01
OK
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU - BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the T4 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
E02 E01
Tester Connection (Symbols)
Specified Condition
T4-2 (E02) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
T4-3 (E01) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
T4
OK
B118155E11
Go to step 11
HX
HX–32
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
5
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SHIFT CONTROL ACTUATOR - BATTERY)
(a) Disconnect the S1 actuator connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
S1
MGNA
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
S1-2 (MGNA) - Body
ground
Power switch ON (IG)
9 to 14 V
NG
Go to step 7
C126783E01
OK
6
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (U, V, W VOLTAGE)
(a) Check the DATA LIST for proper functioning of the shift
control actuator.
Shift control actuator
HX
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
U VOL VAL
U phase voltage value / min: 0 V,
max: 20 V
Actual U phase voltage 9 to 14 V
-
V VOL VAL
V phase voltage value / min: 0 V,
max: 20 V
Actual V phase voltage 9 to 14 V
-
W VOL VAL
W phase voltage value / min: 0 V,
max: 20 V
Actual W phase voltage 9 to 14 V
-
Standard voltage:
9 to 14 V
NG
Go to step 10
OK
REPLACE TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU
7
INSPECT FUSE (P CON MTR)
(a) Remove the P CON MTR H-fuse from the engine room
relay block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the H-fuse.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
NG
HX–33
INSPECT FOR SHORT IN ALL
COMPONENTS CONNECTED TO FUSE AND
REPAIR OR REPLACE THEM IF NEEDED,
AND REPLACE H-FUSE
OK
8
INSPECT TRANSAXLE PARKING LOCK CONTROL RELAY (Marking: P CON)
(a) Remove the P CON relay from the engine room relay
block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the relay.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(When battery voltage is applied to
terminals 1 and 2)
B112776E02
NG
REPLACE TRANSAXLE PARKING LOCK
CONTROL RELAY
OK
9
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU - BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the T4 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
T4
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T4-14 (BMA) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR (TRANSMISSION CONTROL
ECU - BODY GROUND)
BMA
B118155E12
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SHIFT CONTROL ACTUATOR - BATTERY)
HX
HX–34
10
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU - SHIFT CONTROL
ACTUATOR)
(a) Disconnect the T4 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Transmission Control ECU
MWA MVA MUA
T4
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T4-10 (MWA) - S1-1 (MWA)
Below 1 Ω
T4-11 (MVA) - S1-6 (MVA)
Below 1 Ω
T4-12 (MUA) - S1-7 (MUA)
Below 1 Ω
T4-10 (MWA) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
T4-11 (MVA) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
T4-12 (MUA) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
Shift Control Actuator
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
MWA
S1
MVA
MUA
C126765E02
OK
HX
11
INSPECT SHIFT CONTROL ACTUATOR
G030192E01
(a) Remove the 3 bolts and transmission case cover.
(b) Remove the 3 bolts.
(c) Slightly pull the shift control actuator from the hybrid
vehicle transaxle so that the shift control actuator can be
turned.
(d) Turn the shift control actuator.
OK:
The shift control actuator turns smoothly.
HINT:
There may be an internal actuator abnormality if the
actuator does not turn smoothly.
NG
OK
REPLACE TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU
REPLACE SHIFT CONTROL ACTUATOR
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
DTC
C2301
HX–35
Shift Changing Time Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The transmission control ECU receives a P position switch signal from the hybrid vehicle control ECU and
then activates the shift control actuator. At the same time, the transmission control ECU detects the length
of time it takes for the parking lock mechanism to switch. The transmission control ECU outputs this DTC
when this length of time is longer than specification.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C2301
When both conditions below are met:
• Power switch ON (IG).
• There is an internal abnormality in the
shift control actuator for 2 seconds or
more (the parking lock motor runs idle).
•
•
Shift control actuator
Transmission control ECU
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK SHIFT CONTROL ACTUATOR
G030192E01
(a) Remove the 3 bolts and transmission case cover.
(b) Remove the 3 bolts.
(c) Slightly pull the shift control actuator from the hybrid
vehicle transaxle so that the shift control actuator can be
turned.
(d) Turn the shift control actuator.
OK:
The shift control actuator turns smoothly.
HINT:
There may be an internal actuator abnormality if the
actuator does not turn smoothly.
NG
OK
REPLACE TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU
REPLACE SHIFT CONTROL ACTUATOR
HX
HX–36
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
DTC
C2303
Relay Malfunction (+B Short)
DESCRIPTION
The transaxle parking lock control relay (Marking: P CON) is activated by output voltage from the
transmission control ECU and supplies power to the shift control actuator. The transmission control ECU
outputs this DTC when it detects a malfunction in the transaxle parking lock control relay.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C2303
When both conditions below are met:
• The transaxle parking lock control relay is
off.
• Voltage of the transmission control ECU
terminals MUA, MVA, and MWA is 6 V or
more for 64 msec. or more.
•
•
•
Transaxle parking lock control relay (P
CON relay)
Transmission control ECU
Wire harness or connector
WIRING DIAGRAM
Shift Control Actuator
Transmission Control ECU
MWA
V Phase
MWA
MVA
MVA
MGNA
W Phase
U Phase
MUA
MUA
P CON
HX
P CON MTR
BMA
MAIN
Auxiliary Battery
C126769E01
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
HX–37
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT TRANSAXLE PARKING LOCK CONTROL RELAY (Marking: P CON)
(a) Remove the P CON relay from the engine room relay
block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the relay.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(When battery voltage is applied to
terminals 1 and 2)
B112776E02
NG
REPLACE TRANSAXLE PARKING LOCK
CONTROL RELAY
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU - CONTROL RELAY)
(a) Disconnect the T4 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
T4
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T4-14 (BMA) - Body ground
Below 1 V
NG
HX
BMA
B118155E12
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
HX–38
3
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU - ACTUATOR)
(a) Disconnect the T4 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
Transmission Control ECU
T4
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T4-10 (MWA) - Body ground
Below 1 V
T4-11 (MVA) - Body ground
Below 1 V
T4-12 (MUA) - Body ground
Below 1 V
NG
MWA
MVA
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
MUA
B118155E18
OK
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SHIFT CONTROL ACTUATOR - CONTROL RELAY)
(a) Disconnect the S1 actuator connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
S1
MGNA
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S1-2 (MGNA) - Body ground
Below 1 V
NG
HX
C126783E01
OK
REPLACE TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
DTC
C2304
Open or Short Circuit in "U" Phase
DTC
C2305
Open or Short Circuit in "V" Phase
DTC
C2306
Open or Short Circuit in "W" Phase
HX–39
DESCRIPTION
The shift control actuator consists of the parking lock motor and the rotation angle sensor. The
transmission control ECU receives a P position switch signal from the hybrid vehicle control ECU and
activates the parking lock motor by controlling current, causing the parking lock mechanism to switch. The
transmission control ECU outputs this DTC when it detects a malfunction in the parking lock motor
system.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C2304
When both conditions below are met:
• Power switch ON (IG) (battery voltage is 8
V or more).
• Voltage of transmission control ECU
terminal MUA is 6 V or less for 1 second
or more.
•
•
•
When both conditions below are met:
• Power switch ON (IG) (battery voltage is 8
V or more).
• Voltage of transmission control ECU
terminal MVA is 6 V or less for 1 second
or more.
•
•
•
When both conditions below are met:
• Power switch ON (IG) (battery voltage is 8
V or more).
• Voltage of transmission control ECU
terminal MWA is 6 V or less for 1 second
or more.
•
•
•
C2305
C2306
•
•
•
Shift control actuator
Transmission control ECU
Transaxle parking lock control relay (P
CON Relay)
Wire harness or connector
Shift control actuator
Transmission control ECU
Transaxle parking lock control relay (P
CON Relay)
Wire harness or connector
Shift control actuator
Transmission control ECU
Transaxle parking lock control relay (P
CON Relay)
Wire harness or connector
HX
HX–40
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Shift Control Actuator
Transmission Control ECU
MWA
V Phase
MWA
MVA
MVA
MGNA
W Phase
U Phase
MUA
MUA
P CON
P CON MTR
BMA
MAIN
Auxiliary Battery
C126769E01
HX
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FOR DTC
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Turn the intelligent tester on.
Read the DTCs.
Result
Display (DTC output)
Proceed to
C2304, C2305 and C2306 are detected simultaneously
A
C2304, C2305 and C2306 are not detected simultaneously
B
HINT:
• When DTCs C2304, C2305 and C2306 are detected
simultaneously, there may be an open or short circuit
between the shift control actuator and the battery.
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
HX–41
• When DTCs C2304, C2305 and C2306 are not
detected simultaneously, there may be an open or
short circuit in the shift control actuator or between
the actuator and the ECU.
B
Go to step 6
A
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SHIFT CONTROL ACTUATOR - BATTERY)
(a) Disconnect the S1 actuator connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
S1
MGNA
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
S1-2 (MGNA) - Body
ground
Power switch ON (IG)
9 to 14 V
OK
Go to step 6
C126783E01
NG
3
INSPECT FUSE (P CON MTR FUSE)
(a) Remove the P CON MTR H-fuse from the engine room
relay block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the H-fuse.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
INSPECT FOR SHORT IN ALL
COMPONENTS CONNECTED TO FUSE AND
REPAIR OR REPLACE THEM IF NEEDED,
AND REPLACE H-FUSE
OK
4
INSPECT TRANSAXLE PARKING LOCK CONTROL RELAY (Marking: P CON RELAY)
(a) Remove the P CON relay from the engine room relay
block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the relay.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(When battery voltage is applied to
terminals 1 and 2)
B112776E02
NG
REPLACE TRANSAXLE PARKING LOCK
CONTROL RELAY
HX
HX–42
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
OK
5
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU - BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the T4 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
T4
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T4-14 (BMA) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR (TRANSMISSION CONTROL
ECU - BODY GROUND)
BMA
B118155E12
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (SHIFT CONTROL ACTUATOR - BATTERY)
6
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (U, V, W VOLTAGE)
(a) Check the DATA LIST for proper functioning of the shift
control actuator.
Shift control actuator
HX
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
U VOL VAL
U phase voltage value / min: 0 V,
max: 20 V
Actual U phase voltage 9 to 14 V
-
V VOL VAL
V phase voltage value / min: 0 V,
max: 20 V
Actual V phase voltage 9 to 14 V
-
W VOL VAL
W phase voltage value/min: 0 V,
max: 20 V
Actual W phase voltage 9 to 14 V
-
Standard voltage:
9 to 14 V
OK
NG
REPLACE TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
7
HX–43
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU - SHIFT CONTROL
ACTUATOR)
Wire Harness Side
Transmission Control ECU
MWA MVA MUA
T4
(a) Disconnect the T4 ECU connector.
(b) Disconnect the S1 actuator connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T4-10 (MWA) - S1-1 (MWA)
Below 1 Ω
T4-11 (MVA) - S1-6 (MVA)
Below 1 Ω
T4-12 (MUA) - S1-7 (MUA)
Below 1 Ω
T4-10 (MWA) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
T4-11 (MVA) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
T4-12 (MUA) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
Shift Control Actuator
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
MWA
S1
MVA
MUA
C126765E02
OK
REPLACE SHIFT CONTROL ACTUATOR
HX
HX–44
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
DTC
C2307
Power Source Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The shift control actuator consists of the parking lock motor and the rotation angle sensor. The
transmission control ECU receives a P position switch signal from the hybrid vehicle control ECU and
activates the parking lock motor by controlling current, causing the parking lock mechanism to switch. The
transmission control ECU outputs this DTC when it detects a malfunction in the parking lock motor system
and/or the ground circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C2307
When both conditions below are met:
• Power switch ON (IG)
• The parking lock motor current is 50 A or
more, or there is an open in the terminal
E1 circuit of the transmission control ECU
for 0.1 seconds or more.
•
•
•
Transmission control ECU
Wire harness or connector
Parking lock motor (Shift control actuator)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Shift Control Actuator
Transmission Control ECU
MWA
V Phase
MWA
MVA
MVA
MGNA
W Phase
U Phase
MUA
MUA
HX
P CON
P CON MTR
BMA
MAIN
Auxiliary
Battery
E1
C126770E01
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
HX–45
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU - BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the T4 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
T4
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T4-15 (E1) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
E1
B118155E16
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU - BODY GROUND)
(a) Measure the voltage of the wire harness and connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
Tester Connection
T4
MWA MVA MUA
Specified Condition
T4-10 (MWA) - Body ground
Below 1 V
T4-11 (MVA) - Body ground
Below 1 V
T4-12 (MUA) - Body ground
Below 1 V
NG
B118155E13
OK
REPLACE TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
HX
HX–46
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
DTC
C2310
Open or Short Circuit in BATT
DESCRIPTION
The auxiliary battery voltage is constantly applied to terminal BATT. The terminal BATT voltage is used to
power the transmission control ECU memory. The transmission control ECU outputs this DTC when it
detects a malfunction related to terminal BATT.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C2310
When both conditions below are met:
• Power switch ON (IG)
• Terminal BATT voltage of the
transmission control ECU is 10 V or less
for 1 second or more.
•
•
•
P CON MAIN fuse
Transmission control ECU
Wire harness or connector
HINT:
When there is an open or short in the BATT circuit, information on the actuator position ("P position" or
"non-P position") stored in the ECU is cleared every time the power switch is turned OFF. Therefore, the
ECU works to recognize the position each time the power switch is turned ON (IG). As a result, the time
from when the power switch is turned ON (IG) until "READY ON" is indicated may become longer than
normal.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Transmission Control ECU
MAIN
P CON MAIN
BATT
Auxiliary
Battery
HX
C126771E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT FUSE (P CON MAIN)
(a) Remove the P CON MAIN fuse from the engine room
relay block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the fuse.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
P CON
MAIN Fuse
NG
F047675E01
INSPECT FOR SHORT IN ALL
COMPONENTS CONNECTED TO FUSE AND
REPAIR OR REPLACE THEM IF NEEDED,
AND REPLACE FUSE
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
HX–47
OK
2
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (BATT VOLTAGE)
(a) Check the DATA LIST for proper functioning of the
transmission control ECU.
Transmission control ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
BATT VOL VAL
BATT voltage value / min: 0 V,
max: 20 V
Actual power supply voltage 9 to
14 V
-
Standard voltage:
9 to 14 V
OK
REPLACE TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU
NG
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU - P CON MAIN FUSE)
(a) Disconnect the T4 ECU connector.
(b) Remove the P CON fuse from the engine room relay
block.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Transmission Control ECU
T4
BATT
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T4-13 (BATT) - 2 (P CON MAIN Fuse)
Below 1 Ω
T4-13 (BATT) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
Engine Room Relay Block
NG
P CON MAIN Fuse
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
C126778E01
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (P CON MAIN FUSE - BATTERY)
HX
HX–48
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
DTC
C2311
HV Communication Line Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The transmission control ECU receives a P position switch signal from the hybrid vehicle control ECU and
activates the parking lock motor by controlling current, causing the parking lock mechanism to switch. The
transmission control ECU outputs this DTC when it detects a communication error between the hybrid
vehicle control ECU and the transmission control ECU.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C2311
When both conditions below are met:
• Power switch ON (IG)
• Signals from the hybrid control ECU
cannot be received, or there is a problem
with a pulse signal from the hybrid vehicle
control ECU for 1 second or more.
•
•
•
Transmission control ECU
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
Wire harness or connector
WIRING DIAGRAM
Hybrid Vehicle Control ECU
PCON
Transmission Control ECU
PCON
C126772E01
HX
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
HX–49
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU (PCON SIGNAL)
(a) Check output waveform.
(1) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(2) Using an oscilloscope, check the output waveform
of the transmission control ECU connector.
OK:
The output waveform appears as shown in the
illustration.
PCON
T4
121110 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
26 25 24 23 22 21 20
19 18 17 16 15 14 13
E1
Normal Signal Waveform
Item
Contents
Symbols (Terminal No.)
PCON (T4-7) - E1 (T4-15)
Tool setting
5 V/DIV., 20 msec./DIV.
Vehicle condition
Power switch ON (IG)
OK
REPLACE TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU
GND
C136043E01
NG
HX
HX–50
2
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU - TRANSMISSION CONTROL
ECU)
(a) Disconnect the T4 and H17 ECU connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Transmission Control ECU
T4
PCON
Tester Connection (Symbols)
Specified Condition
T4-7 (PCON) - H17-9 (PCON)
Below 1 Ω
T4-7 (PCON) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
Hybrid Vehicle Control ECU
H17
PCON
C126779E01
OK
HX
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
DTC
C2312
HX–51
Power Source Control ECU Communication
Line Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The transmission control ECU receives power switch condition signals (OFF / ON (ACC) / ON (IG)) from
the power source control ECU. The transmission control ECU outputs this DTC when it does not receive
the signals.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C2312
When both conditions below are met:
• Power switch ON (IG)
• Signals from the power source control
ECU cannot be received for 10 seconds
or more.
•
•
Transmission control ECU
Power source control ECU
HX
HX–52
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Transmission Control ECU
Certification ECU
MPX1
MPX1
Transponder key ECU
MPX2
MPX2
IGCT
P/I
HEV
+B
Hybrid Vehicle Control ECU
MAIN
MREL
E1
HX
C126773E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (P SPLY OFF SIGNAL)
(a) Check the DATA LIST for proper functioning of the
transmission control ECU.
Transmission control ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
P SPLY OFF SIG
Power supply off preparation
request signal / ON or OFF
ON: Power is turned off by power
source control ECU after
receiving power switch OFF
signal
OFF: Any other condition
-
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
HX–53
OK:
ON is displayed.
NG
REPLACE POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU
OK
REPLACE TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU
HX
HX–54
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
DTC
C2315
HV System Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The transmission control ECU receives a P position switch signal from the hybrid vehicle control ECU and
activates the parking lock motor by controlling current, causing the parking lock mechanism to switch.
When the hybrid control ECU detects a malfunction with the P position switch or P position signal, it sends
an information signal to the transmission control ECU. After receiving this signal, the transmission control
ECU outputs this DTC.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C2315
When both conditions below are met:
• Power switch ON (IG)
• A malfunction signal from the hybrid
control ECU is received for 1 second or
more.
•
•
•
•
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
P position switch
Transmission control ECU
Wire harness or connector
WIRING DIAGRAM
Hybrid Vehicle Control ECU
Transmission Control ECU
PCON
PCON
C126772E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK OTHER DTC OUTPUT (BESIDES DTC C2315)
HX
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Turn the intelligent tester on.
(d) Read the DTCs.
Result
Result
Proceed to
No output
A
P0851-579, P0852-580, P3102-597, 598 and 599
B
HINT:
• DTCs P0851 and P0852 indicate P position switch
malfunctions. DTC P0851-579 indicates "short to
ground" and P0852-580 indicates "open" or "short to
+B".
• DTC P3102 indicates a P position signal error. DTC
P3102-597 indicates "short to ground", P3102-598
indicates "short to +B", and P3102-599 indicates
"duty ratio error".
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
B
HX–55
REPAIR CIRCUIT INDICATED BY OUTPUT
CODE
A
REPLACE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
HX
HX–56
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
DTC
C2318
Low Voltage Error (Power Supply Malfunction)
DESCRIPTION
The auxiliary battery voltage is applied to terminal +B when the power switch is ON (IG). The transmission
control ECU outputs this DTC when the input voltage drops.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble area
C2318
When both conditions below are met:
• Power switch ON (IG)
• Terminal +B voltage of the transmission
control ECU is 9.3 V or less for 1 second
or more.
•
•
•
•
HEV fuse
IGCT relay
Wire harness or connector
Auxiliary battery
WIRING DIAGRAM
Hybrid Vehicle Control ECU
Transmission Control ECU
IGCT
P/I
HEV
+B
MREL
MAIN
Auxiliary
Battery
HX
C126774E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT FUSE (HEV)
(a) Remove the HEV fuse from the engine room relay block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the fuse.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
HEV Fuse
F044949E01
INSPECT FOR SHORT IN ALL
COMPONENTS CONNECTED TO FUSE AND
REPAIR OR REPLACE THEM IF NEEDED,
AND REPLACE FUSE
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
HX–57
OK
2
CHECK OTHER DTC OUTPUT (BESIDE C2318)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Turn the intelligent tester on.
(d) Read the DTCs.
Result
Result
Proceed to
No output
A
P3110-223
B
HINT:
DTC P3110 indicates HV main relay malfunction. DTC
P3110-223 indicates "IGCT relay malfunction".
B
REPAIR CIRCUIT INDICATED BY OUTPUT
CODE
A
3
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (IG (+B) VOLTAGE)
(a) Check the DATA LIST for proper functioning of the
transmission control ECU.
Transmission control ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Range (Display)
Normal Condition
IG (+B) VOL VAL
IG (+B) voltage value / min: 0 V, max: 20 V
Actual power supply voltage 9 to 14 V
Standard voltage:
9 to 14 V
OK
REPLACE TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (ENGINE ROOM RELAY BLOCK AND
JUNCTION BLOCK - TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU)
HX
HX–58
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
"P" Position Switch Indicator Light Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The parking lock switch indicator light comes on or goes off to indicate the on/off status of the P position
switch and blinks to indicate malfunction conditions of the system.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Transmission Control ECU
P Position Switch
MAIN
P CON MAIN
IND
Auxiliary
Battery
C126775E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK INDICATOR LIGHT
(a) Inspect the indicator light condition by operating the P
position switch.
Result
HX
Condition
Proceed to
Indicator light does not go off.
A
Indicator light does not come on.
B
B
A
Go to step 3
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
2
HX–59
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU - P POSITION SWITCH)
(a) Disconnect the T4 ECU connector.
(b) Disconnect the M11 switch connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Transmission Control ECU
T4
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T4-9 (IND) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
IND
B118155E17
OK
REPLACE TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU
3
INSPECT FUSE (P CON MAIN)
(a) Remove the P CON MAIN fuse from the engine room
relay block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the fuse.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
P CON
MAIN Fuse
NG
F047675E01
OK
INSPECT FOR SHORT IN ALL
COMPONENTS CONNECTED TO FUSE AND
REPAIR OR REPLACE THEM IF NEEDED,
AND REPLACE FUSE
HX
HX–60
4
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU - BATTERY)
(a) Disconnect the T4 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
Transmission Control ECU
T4
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T4-9 (IND) - Body ground
9 to 14 V
OK
REPLACE TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU
IND
B118155E17
NG
5
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU - P POSITION SWITCH)
(a) Disconnect the T4 ECU connector.
(b) Disconnect the M11 switch connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Transmission Control ECU
T4
IND
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T4-9 (IND) - M11-6
Below 1 Ω
NG
HX
P Position Switch
M11
C126780E01
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – ELECTRONIC SHIFT LEVER SYSTEM
6
HX–61
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (P POSITION SWITCH - BATTERY)
(a) Disconnect the M11 switch connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
M11
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
M11-5 - Body ground
9 to 14 V
OK
REPLACE P POSITION SWITCH
C126781E01
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
HX
HX–58
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – COOLANT
COOLANT
REPLACEMENT
1.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
2.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
3.
DRAIN COOLANT
(a) Remove the transaxle-side reserve tank cap.
CAUTION:
Do not remove the reserve tank cap while the
engine is hot.
(b) Remove the plug shown in the illustration and drain
the coolant into a container.
(c) Install the plug with a new gasket.
Torque: 39 N*m (400 kgf*cm, 29 ft.*lbf)
C098375E01
4.
ADD COOLANT
(a) Loosen the bleeder plug shown in the illustration
and connect a hose.
NOTICE:
Insert one end of the hose into the bleeder tank.
C098376E01
HX
C098377E01
(b) Add coolant until the level of coolant in the hose
attached to the bleeder tank reaches the same level
as the FULL line of the reserve tank.
NOTICE:
Add genuine Toyota Super LLC coolant.
(c) Close the bleeder plug.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and run the water
pump for approximately 20 seconds.
(e) Turn the power switch OFF. (1*)
(f) Loosen the bleeder plug and bleed the air from the
transaxle.
(g) Add coolant into the bleeder tank. (*3)
(h) Repeat the steps *1, *2 and *3.
Standard:
Water pump noise becomes softer and coolant
circulation in reserve tank improves. Coolant
system air bleeding is complete
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – COOLANT
(i)
(j)
5.
HX–59
HINT:
If air remains in the coolant system, the water pump
noise becomes louder and the coolant circulation in
the reserve tank becomes worse.
Turn the power switch ON (IG) and run the water
pump for approximately 5 minutes after completing
air bleeding of the coolant system.
NOTICE:
Ensure that the bleeder plug is closed.
Add coolant until the reserve tank is filled up to the
FULL mark.
CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKAGE
(a) Check for engine coolant leakage (see page CO-9).
C098378E01
HX
HX–60
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – SHIFT CONTROL ACTUATOR
SHIFT CONTROL ACTUATOR
HYBRID SYSTEM
TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE
COMPONENTS
TRANSMISSION CASE COVER
16 (163, 12)
HX
7.0 (71, 62 in.*lbf)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
SHIFT CONTROL ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
C129403E01
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – SHIFT CONTROL ACTUATOR
HX–61
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE SHIFT CONTROL ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the 3 bolts and transmission case cover
from the hybrid vehicle transaxle.
C098379E02
(c) Remove the 3 bolts and shift control actuator from
the hybrid vehicle transaxle.
HX
Z035712E01
INSTALLATION
1.
G030526E01
INSTALL SHIFT CONTROL ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Apply a small amount of ATF WS to the O-ring.
HX–62
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – SHIFT CONTROL ACTUATOR
(b) Install the shift control actuator to the hybrid vehicle
transaxle with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 16 N*m (163 kgf*cm, 12 ft.*lbf)
Z035712E01
(c) Install the transmission case cover to the hybrid
vehicle transaxle with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 7.0 N*m (71 kgf*cm, 62 in.*lbf)
(d) Connect the connector.
HX
C098379E02
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
HX–63
HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
HYBRID SYSTEM
TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE
COMPONENTS
11 (112, 8)
INVERTER COVER
INVERTER RESERVOIR TANK
21 (214, 15)
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
HX
ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C129404E01
HX–64
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
80 (816, 59)
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
NO. 3 ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
62 (630, 46)
GASKET
EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY
x6
33 (337, 24)
HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
INTERMEDIATE SHAFT
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT RH
49 (357, 26)
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT LH
CLIP
49 (500, 36)
COLUMN HOLE COVER
216 (2,203, 159)
CLIP
HX
49 (500, 24)
74 (755, 55)
74 (755, 55)
TORQUE ROD
157 (1,601, 116)
100 (1,020, 74)
89 (908, 65)
60 (612, 44)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
113 (1,152, 83)
FRONT SUSPENSION CROSSMEMBER SUB-ASSEMBLY
Non-reusable part
C129405E01
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
HX–65
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT SPEED SENSOR (RESOLVER)
A
B
A077571E01
Connector B
MCS
MCSG
GSN
MRF
MSNG
MRFG
(a) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance
between the terminals.
A077568E05
Connector A
GRF
GSN
GCS
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
GRFG
GSNG
GCSG
A077568E04
Specified Condition
A1 (GCS) - A4 (GCSG)
12.6 to 16.8 Ω
A2 (GSN) - A5 (GSNG)
12.6 to 16.8 Ω
A3 (GRF) - A6 (GRFG)
7.65 to 10.2 Ω
B1 (MRF) - B4 (MRFG)
7.65 to 10.2 Ω
B2 (MSN) - B5 (MSNG)
12.6 to 16.8 Ω
B3 (MCS) - B6 (MCSG)
12.6 to 16.8 Ω
All of terminals above - Transaxle
housing
10 kΩ or higher
If the results are not as specified, replace the hybrid
vehicle transaxle assembly.
HX
HX–66
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
2.
INSPECT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
C
A083656E02
Connector C
OMT
OMTG
MMT
(a) Using an ohmmeter, measure the resistance
between the terminals.
MMTG
A077568E06
HX
Resistance kΩ
Standard resistance
120
110
100
90
80
70
60
50
40
30
20
10
0
10 (50)15 (59) 20 (68) 25 (77) 30 (86) 35 (95)
Sensor Temperature °C (°F)
A125180E01
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
C1 (MMT) - C4 (MMTG)
87.3 to 110.5 kΩ at 10°C (50°F)
23.8 to 28.5 kΩ at 40°C (104°F)
C3 (OMT) - C6 (OMTG)
87.3 to 110.5 kΩ at 10°C (50°F)
23.8 to 28.5 kΩ at 40°C (104°F)
All of terminals above - Transaxle
housing
1 MΩ or higher
HINT:
The standard varies according to the sensor
temperature. If the results are not as specified,
replace the hybrid vehicle transaxle assembly.
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
HX–67
REMOVAL
CAUTION:
• When working on the high voltage systems, always
wear insulated gloves.
• Keep the removed service plug in your pocket to
prevent other technicians from reconnecting it while
you are servicing the vehicle.
• After removing the service plug grip, do not touch the
high voltage connectors and terminals for 5 minutes.
NOTICE:
After removing the service plug grip, do not operate the
power switch as it may damage the hybrid vehicle
control ECU.
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE SERVICE PLUG GRIP
(a) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-153).
3.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
4.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
5.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
6.
DRAIN COOLANT
(a) Drain the coolant (see page HX-58).
7.
DRAIN TRANSAXLE OIL
(a) Drain the transaxle oil (see page HX-1).
8.
REMOVE HOOD SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the hood (see page ED-2).
9.
REMOVE FRONT WIPER ARM LH
(a) Remove the front wiper arm LH (see page WW-13).
10. REMOVE FRONT WIPER ARM RH
(a) Remove the front wiper arm RH (see page WW-13).
11. REMOVE COWL TOP FRONT PANEL SUBASSEMBLY OUTER
(a) Remove the cowl top front panel (see page WW13).
12. REMOVE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the inverter with converter (see page HV533).
13. REMOVE AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the air cleaner (see page ES-450).
HX
HX–68
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
14. DISCONNECT WIRE HARNESS
(a) Disconnect the 3 connectors shown in the
illustration and the clamp.
Front
G030089E01
(b) Disconnect the 2 clamps shown in the illustration.
Front
C098456E01
(c) Disconnect the connector.
(d) Remove the 3 bolts and transmission case cover
from the hybrid vehicle transaxle.
HX
C098379E02
(e) Disconnect the 2 clamps.
Front
Z035713E01
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
(f)
HX–69
Remove the bolt and ground wire.
Front
C098457E01
15. DISCONNECT NO. 4 INVERTER COOLING HOSE
(a) Remove the 4 clamps and disconnect the 3 hoses.
16. REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the front drive shaft (see page DS-4).
17. DISCONNECT EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the exhaust pipe (see page EX-2).
Clamp
Front
Clamp
18. REMOVE FRONT SUSPENSION CROSSMEMBER
SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page EM-96)
C097764E01
No. 1 Engine
Hanger
Front
No. 2 Engine
Hanger
Rear
D025372E01
19. SUSPEND ENGINE ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the 2 PCV hoses.
(b) Install the No. 1 and No. 2 engine hangers in the
correct direction.
Parts No.:
No. 1 engine hanger:
12281-22021
No. 2 engine hanger:
12281-15040
Bolt:
91512-B1016
Torque: 38 N*m (387 kgf*cm, 28 ft.*lbf)
(c) Attach an engine chain hoist to the engine hangers.
CAUTION:
Do not attempt to hang the engine by hooking
the chain to any other parts.
20. SUPPORT HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE
ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a transmission jack, support the hybrid
vehicle transaxle.
21. DISCONNECT NO. 3 ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET
(a) Remove the nut and disconnect the engine
mounting bracket from the engine mounting
insulator.
Front
C098372E01
HX
HX–70
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
Front
22. REMOVE HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE
ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 bolts, starter cover and housing side
cover.
G030261E01
(b) Remove the 6 bolts and hybrid vehicle transaxle.
NOTICE:
To avoid damage to the knock pin, do not pry
the connecting portion of the HV transaxle and
the engine.
Pin
Pin
G031001E01
23. REMOVE NO. 6 INVERTER COOLING HOSE
(a) Remove the clamp and inverter cooling hose.
Front
C098448E01
HX
24. REMOVE NO. 3 ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET
(a) Remove the 3 bolts and engine mounting bracket.
Front
C098374E01
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
HX–71
(b) Remove the 6 bolts shown in the illustration and
clamp.
C098449E01
HX
HX–72
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
INSTALLATION
CAUTION:
• When working on the high voltage systems, always
wear insulated gloves.
• Keep the removed service plug in your pocket to
prevent other technicians from reconnecting it while
you are servicing the vehicle.
• After removing the service plug grip, do not touch the
high voltage connectors and terminals for 5 minutes.
NOTICE:
After removing the service plug grip, do not operate the
power switch as it may damage the hybrid vehicle
control ECU.
1.
HX
INSTALL NO. 3 ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET
(a) Install the clump in the position shown in the
illustration with the 6 bolts.
Torque: 9.0 N*m (92 kgf*cm, 80 in.*lbf)
C098449E01
(b) Install the No. 3 engine mounting bracket with the 3
bolts.
Torque: 52 N*m (530 kgf*cm, 38 ft.*lbf)
Front
C098374E01
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
HX–73
2.
INSTALL NO. 6 INVERTER COOLING HOSE
(a) Connect the inverter cooling hose and install the
clamp.
3.
INSTALL HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the hybrid vehicle transaxle with the 6 bolts.
Torque: 33 N*m (337 kgf*cm, 24 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
• Ensure that the knock pin is installed on the
engine side.
• Place the HV transaxle in a horizontal
position and Align the knock pin and its hole.
Then tighten the 6 bolts in the positions
shown in the illustration.
Front
C098448E01
Pin
Pin
G031001E01
(b) Install the housing side cover and starter cover with
the 2 bolts.
Torque: 32 N*m (326 kgf*cm, 23 ft.*lbf)
Front
G030261E01
4.
5.
REMOVE NO. 1 ENGINE HANGER
(a) Remove the bolt and engine hanger.
6.
INSTALL FRONT SUSPENSION CROSSMEMBER
SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page EM-106)
7.
CONNECT EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY
(a) Connect the exhaust pipe (see page EX-3).
8.
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the front drive shaft (see page DS-15).
Front
C098372E01
INSTALL NO. 3 ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET
(a) Install the engine mounting bracket to the engine
mounting insulator with the nut.
Torque: 80 N*m (816 kgf*cm, 59 ft.*lbf)
HX
HX–74
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
9.
CONNECT NO. 4 INVERTER COOLING HOSE
(a) Connect the 3 hoses with the 4 clamps.
Clamp
Clamp
Front
C097764E01
10. CONNECT CONNECTOR
(a) Connect the ground wire with the bolt.
Torque: 9.0 N*m (92 kgf*cm, 80 in.*lbf)
Front
C098457E01
(b) Connect the 2 clamps.
Front
Z035713E01
(c) Install the transmission case cover to the hybrid
vehicle transaxle with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 7.0 N*m (71 kgf*cm, 62 in.*lbf)
(d) Connect the connector.
HX
C098379E02
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
HX–75
(e) Connect the clamps in the 2 locations shown in the
illustration.
Front
C098456E01
(f)
Connect the clamp and the 3 connectors shown in
the illustration.
11. INSTALL AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the air cleaner (see page ES-453).
12. INSTALL INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
(a) Install with inverter converter (see page HV-535).
Front
G030089E01
13. INSTALL COWL TOP FRONT PANEL SUBASSEMBLY OUTER
(a) Install the cowl top front panel (see page WW-15).
14. INSTALL FRONT WIPER ARM RH
(a) Install the front wiper arm (see page WW-16).
15. INSTALL FRONT WIPER ARM LH
(a) Install the front wiper arm (see page WW-16).
16. INSTALL HOOD SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the hood (see page ED-4).
17. ADJUST HOOD SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Adjust the hood (see page ED-4).
18. INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
19. INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
20. INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
21. INSTALL SERVICE PLUG GRIP
(a) Install the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
22. CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
23. ADD TRANSAXLE OIL
Fluid type:
Toyota genuine ATF WS
Standard capacity:
3.8 liters (4.0 US qts, 3.3 Imp. qts)
24. INSPECT TRANSAXLE OIL
(a) Inspect the transaxle oil (see page HX-1).
25. ADD COOLANT
(a) Add the coolant (see page HX-58).
26. CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKAGE
(a) Check for engine coolant leakage (see page CO-9).
HX
HX–76
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
27. INSPECT AND ADJUST FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
(a) Inspect and adjust the front wheel alignment (see
page SP-2).
28. PERFORM CALIBRATION
(a) Perform calibration (see page PS-13).
29. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
HX
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE UNIT
HX–75
HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE UNIT
HYBRID SYSTEM
TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE
COMPONENTS
MOTOR WATER JACKET COVER
NO. 3 ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET
SHIFT CONTROL ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
TRANSMISSION CASE COVER
52 (530, 38)
7.0 (71, 62 in.*lbf)
39 (398, 29)
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
SET PLUG
16 (160, 12)
GASKET
PARKING SHAFT COVER
O-RING
7.9 (81, 70 in.*lbf)
MANUAL DETENT SPRING
MANUAL DETENT
SPRING COVER
TRANSMISSION
OIL STRAINER
9.8 (100, 86 in.*lbf)
25 (255, 18)
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
x8
39 (398, 29)
SET PLUG
GASKET
PARKING COVER
5.8 (59, 51 in.*lbf)
55 (561, 41)
HX
HYBRID TRANSAXLE OIL SEAL LH
SCREW PLUG
MOTOR STATOR WIRING
HARNESS CONNECTOR
5.8 (59, 51 in.*lbf)
MOTOR REVOLUTION SENSOR
WIRING HARNESS CONNECTOR
x5
5.7 (58, 50 in.*lbf)
OIL PUMP DRIVE SHAFT
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
DRIVEN ROTOR
Non-reusable part
Apply ATF WS
Apply MP grease
O-RING
DRIVE ROTOR
OIL PUMP COVER
O-RING
7.4 (75, 65 in.*lbf)
OIL PUMP COVER PLUG
C129406E01
HX–76
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE UNIT
BREATHER PLUG
POWER CABLE COVER
HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY TYPE T OIL SEAL
HYBRID TRANSAXLE OIL SEAL RH
15 (155, 11)
TRANSAXLE HOUSING TUBE CONNECTOR
x 13
13 (133, 10)
SCREW PLUG
25 (255, 18)
COUNTER DRIVEN GEAR SUB-ASSEMBLY
OUTER RACE
DIFFERENTIAL CASE ASSEMBLY
4.8 (49, 42 in.*lbf)
OUTER RACE
5.8 (59, 51 in.*lbf)
39 (400, 29)
GASKET
GENERATOR MOTOR
REVOLUTION SENSOR
WIRING HARNESS
CONNECTOR
SET PLUG
SPROCKET DRIVEN GEAR
AND COUNTER DRIVE GEAR
SHIM
CHAIN
SHIM
THRUST NEEDLE ROLLER BEARING
HX
TRANSMISSION DRIVE
SPROCKET SUB-ASSEMBLY
THRUST BEARING RACE
PLANETARY RING GEAR
5.8 (59, 51 in.*lbf)
8.5 (87, 75 in.*lbf)
NEEDLE ROLLER
BEARING
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
INPUT SHAFT ASSEMBLY
THRUST BEARING RACE
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
PLANETARY RING GEAR FLANGE
SHIM
GENERATOR CABLE
Apply ATF WS
Apply MP grease
C129407E01
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE UNIT
HX–77
DISASSEMBLY
CAUTION:
• When working on the high voltage systems, always
wear insulated gloves.
• Keep the removed service plug in your pocket to
prevent other technicians from reconnecting it while
you are servicing the vehicle.
• After removing the service plug grip, do not touch the
high voltage connectors and terminals for 5 minutes.
NOTICE:
After removing the service plug grip, do not operate the
power switch as it may damage the hybrid vehicle
control ECU.
1.
REMOVE HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE
ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the hybrid vehicle transaxle (see page HX66).
2.
REMOVE HYBRID VEHICLE GENERATOR
ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the 2 engine hangers in the positions shown
in the illustration.
HINT:
• Engine hanger: 12281-67070, S1228-11781
• Bolt: 91642-81045, 91642-81265
• Nut: 90178-10001, 90179-12147
(b) Using an engine sling device and chain block, set
the transaxle with the generator side facing upward.
NOTICE:
• Place the transaxle on wooden blocks or
equivalent.
• Fix the transaxle so that no excessive force is
applied to the cable.
(c) Remove the drain plug.
C098482E01
(d) Remove the 21 bolts shown in the illustration.
HINT:
• 13 bolts on the generator side.
• 8 bolts on the motor side.
C099316E01
HX
HX–78
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE UNIT
(e) Disconnect the motor and generator by inserting a
flat-head screwdriver in the position shown and
prying the two apart.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the two faces of each
part.
(f) Using an engine sling device and chain block, raise
the generator.
HINT:
Raise the generator approximately 30 to 40 mm
(1.18 to 1.57 in.).
C099317E01
(g) Apply protective tape to the head of a flat-head
screwdriver and use it to hold down the chain with
input shaft while removing the generator.
C099318E01
HX
Counter Driven Gear
3.
REMOVE COUNTER DRIVEN GEAR SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the counter driven gear from the HV motor.
4.
REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL CASE ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the differential case from the HV motor.
C099319E02
Differential Case
C069292E02
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE UNIT
5.
Thrust
Bearing
Race
HX–79
REMOVE TRANSMISSION DRIVE SPROCKET SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the thrust bearing race, thrust needle roller
bearing and No. 1 thrust bearing race.
HINT:
The thrust bearing race may be attached to the
generator side.
Thrust Needle Roller Bearing
C069408E01
(b) Remove the drive sprocket and chain.
Chain
C069293E01
6.
REMOVE INPUT SHAFT ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the input shaft.
7.
REMOVE PLANETARY RING GEAR
(a) Remove the thrust bearing race, thrust needle roller
bearing and No. 1 thrust bearing race.
HINT:
The thrust bearing race may be attached to the
input shaft side.
Input Shaft
C069294E01
Thrust Needle
Roller Bearing
Thrust
Bearing
Race
C069295E01
(b) Remove the planetary ring rear.
Planetary
Ring Gear
C069296E01
HX
HX–80
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE UNIT
Planetary Ring
Gear Flange
8.
REMOVE PLANETARY RING GEAR FLANGE
(a) Remove the planetary ring gear flange and shim.
9.
REMOVE SPROCKET DRIVEN GEAR AND COUNTER
DRIVE GEAR
(a) Using a plastic-faced hammer, tap the motor case
and remove the counter drive gear and shim.
HINT:
Remove the counter drive gear while pulling it
vertically.
Shim
G030634E01
Sprocket Driven
and Counter
Drive Gear
Shim
C099320E02
10. FIX TRANSMISSION OIL STRAINER
(a) Remove the bolt and oil strainer.
C099321E01
(b) Remove the O-ring from the oil strainer.
HX
O-ring
Transmission
Oil Strainer
C099322E01
11. REMOVE HV MOTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Place the motor on wooden blocks or equivalent.
C099323E01
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE UNIT
HX–81
12. REMOVE NO. 3 ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET
(a) Remove the 3 bolts and mounting bracket.
G022584E01
Motor Revolution
Sensor Wiring
Harness Connector
G032406E01
13. REMOVE MOTOR REVOLUTION SENSOR WIRING
HARNESS CONNECTOR
(a) Remove the bolt and pull out the HV motor side
motor revolution sensor wiring harness connector
(gray).
NOTICE:
Do not pull on the connector any more than
necessary.
(b) Remove the connector and motor revolution sensor
wiring harness connector (gray).
14. REMOVE MOTOR STATOR WIRING HARNESS
CONNECTOR
(a) Remove the bolt and pull out the motor stator wiring
harness connector (black).
NOTICE:
Do not pull on the sensor connector any more
than necessary.
(b) Disconnect the connector and the motor stator
wiring harness connector (black).
Motor Stator Wiring
Harness Connector
G032407E01
15. REMOVE SHIFT CONTROL ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 3 bolts and shift control actuator.
Shift Control
Actuator
C099561E03
16. REMOVE PARKING COVER
(a) Remove the 6 bolts and parking cover.
C099324E01
HX
HX–82
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE UNIT
17. REMOVE MANUAL DETENT SPRING SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the bolt, manual detent spring cover and
manual detent spring.
Manual Detent Spring
Manual Detent
Spring Cover
C099325E01
18. REMOVE MOTOR WATER JACKET COVER
(a) Remove the 6 bolts and motor water jacket cover.
C069307E01
19. REMOVE PARKING SHAFT COVER
(a) Remove the 5 bolts and parking shaft cover.
C099326E01
20. REMOVE TRANSMISSION OIL PUMP COVER SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the oil pump cover plug and O-ring.
HX
O-Ring
C099327E02
(b) Remove the 5 bolts and oil pump cover.
C099328E01
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE UNIT
HX–83
(c) Remove the O-ring.
O-ring
G031019E01
Driven
Rotor
21. REMOVE OIL PUMP DRIVE SHAFT
(a) Remove the oil pump drive rotor and oil pump
driven rotor.
Drive Rotor
C099329E01
(b) Remove the oil pump drive shaft.
C099330E01
22. REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL CASE LH TAPERED
ROLLER BEARING RACE
(a) Using SST, tap out the differential case tapered
roller bearing LH outer race and shim.
SST 09308-00010
SST
G031002E01
23. REMOVE HYBRID TRANSAXLE OIL SEAL LH
(a) Place the motor on wooden blocks or equivalent.
NOTICE:
Make sure that the parking lock rod does not
contact the wooden blocks.
C099331E01
HX
HX–84
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE UNIT
(b) Using SST, tap out the oil seal.
SST 09308-00010
SST
G031003E01
24. REMOVE TRANSAXLE HOUSING AND CASE WITH
HEAD STRAIGHT SCREW PLUG
(a) Remove the 2 set plugs and gasket.
(b) Using a 10 mm hexagon wrench, remove the screw
plugs.
Set Plug
Screw Plug
C099333E01
25. FIX HYBRID VEHICLE GENERATOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Place the generator on wooden blocks or
equivalent.
C069323E01
26. REMOVE POWER CABLE COVER
(a) Remove the breather plug.
HX
C099334E01
(b) Remove the 4 bolts and power cable cover.
C099335E01
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE UNIT
HX–85
27. REMOVE GENERATOR CABLE
(a) Remove the 5 bolts and generator cable.
B
A
A
A
B
C099539E01
C099540E01
28. REMOVE GENERATOR MOTOR REVOLUTION
SENSOR WIRING HARNESS CONNECTOR
(a) Remove the bolt and pull out the HV generator side
generator revolution sensor wiring harness
connector.
NOTICE:
Do not pull on the sensor connector any more
than necessary.
(b) Disconnect the connector and the HV generator
side generator revolution sensor wiring harness
connector.
29. REMOVE TRANSAXLE HOUSING TUBE
CONNECTOR
C069328E01
SST
30. REMOVE HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE
ASSEMBLY TYPE T OIL SEAL
(a) Using SST, remove the oil seal.
SST 09612-30012
G031004E01
31. REMOVE HYBRID TRANSAXLE OIL SEAL RH
(a) Using SST, tap out the oil seal.
SST 09308-00010
SST
G031005E01
HX
HX–86
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE UNIT
32. REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL CASE RH TAPERED
ROLLER BEARING RACE
(a) Using SST, tap out the differential case tapered
roller bearing LH outer race.
SST 09308-00010
SST
G031006E01
33. REMOVE TRANSAXLE HOUSING AND CASE WITH
HEAD STRAIGHT SCREW PLUG
(a) Remove the set plug and gasket.
(b) Using a 6 mm socket wrench, remove the screw
plug.
Screw Plug
Set Plug
G031007E01
INSPECTION
1.
C069413E01
HX
Set Plug
REASSEMBLY
1.
Screw Plug
G031008E01
INSPECT HV MOTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Inspect the inside diameter of the rotor bush.
(1) Using a caliper gauge, measure the inside
diameter of the motor rotor bush.
Standard diameter:
20.025 to 20.046 mm (0.7884 to 0.7892 in.)
Maximum diameter:
20.096 mm (0.7912 in.)
NOTICE:
Take the measurement in different locations
and use the average of the measurements
taken.
If the inside diameter exceeds the maximum,
replace the motor assembly with a new one.
INSTALL TRANSAXLE HOUSING AND CASE WITH
HEAD STRAIGHT SCREW PLUG
(a) Install a new gasket and the set plug.
Torque: 39 N*m (400 kgf*cm, 29 ft.*lbf)
(b) Apply liquid sealant 1344 to the first 2 to 3 threads
from the end of the screw plug.
NOTICE:
Clean and degrease the screw and screw hole.
(c) Using a 6 mm socket hexagon wrench, install the
screw plug.
Torque: 13 N*m (130 kgf*cm, 9 ft.*lbf)
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE UNIT
HX–87
2.
INSTALL TRANSAXLE HOUSING AND CASE WITH
HEAD STRAIGHT SCREW PLUG
(a) Install a new gasket and the set plug.
Torque: 39 N*m (400 kgf*cm, 29 ft.*lbf)
HINT:
Tighten the set plug after adding transaxle oil.
(b) Apply liquid sealant 1324 to the first 2 to 3 threads
from the end of the screw plug.
NOTICE:
Clean and degrease the screw and screw hole.
(c) Using a 10 mm socket hexagon wrench, install the
screw plug.
Torque: 55 N*m (561 kgf*cm, 41 ft.*lbf)
3.
INSTALL HYBRID TRANSAXLE OIL SEAL RH
(a) Using SST, tap in a new oil seal.
Oil seal depth:
2.7 +-0.5 mm (0.106 +-0.020 in.)
(b) Coat the lip of the oil seal with No. 2 MP grease.
SST 09350-32014 (09351-32130, 09351-32150),
09950-70010 (09951-07100)
4.
INSTALL HYBRID TRANSAXLE TYPE T OIL SEAL LH
(a) Place the motor on wooden blocks or equivalent.
NOTICE:
Make sure that the parking lock rod does not
contact the wooden blocks.
Set Plug
Screw Plug
C099333E01
SST
G031010E01
C099331E01
HX
(b) Using SST, tap in the oil seal.
Standard depth:
2.7 +-0.5 mm (0.106 +-0.020 in.)
(c) Coat the lip of the oil seal with MP grease.
SST 09350-32014 (09351-32130, 09351-32150),
09950-70010 (09951-07100)
SST
C099542E01
HX–88
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE UNIT
5.
ADJUST PRELOAD
(a) Adjust the differential case preload.
(1) Place the motor on wooden blocks or
equivalent.
NOTICE:
• Place the motor horizontally.
• Excessive force should not be applied to
the cable.
C099543E01
(2) Using SST, tap in the differential case tapered
roller bearing LH outer race and shim to the
motor.
SST 09950-60020 (09951-00680), 0995070010 (09951-07100)
NOTICE:
Replace the shim and outer race with new
ones if they are deformed or damaged.
SST
G031011E01
(3) Using SST, tap in the differential case tapered
roller bearing RH outer race to the generator.
SST 09950-60020 (09951-00680), 0995070010 (09951-07100)
NOTICE:
Replace the outer race with a new one if it is
deformed or damaged.
SST
G031012E01
(4) Apply ATF WS to the sliding surfaces of the
differential case tapered roller bearing and
install the bearing to the motor.
HX
C069368E01
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE UNIT
HX–89
(5) Using an engine sling device and chain block,
install the motor to the generator.
HINT:
• Engine hanger: 12281-67070, S1228-11781
• Bolt: 91642-81045, 91642-81265
• Nut: 90178-10001, 90179-12147
C069026E01
(6) Tighten the 13 bolts in the positions shown in
the illustration.
Torque: 25 N*m (250 kgf*cm, 18 ft.*lbf)
G030401E01
(7) Using SST, rotate the differential case in both
directions to stabilize the bearings.
SST 09564-32011
SST
G031013E01
SST
G031014E01
(8) Using SST, measure the differential preload of
the differential case and rotation torque.
SST 09564-32011
Standard preload (Starting torque):
0.98 to 1.57 N*m (9.99 to 16.01 kgf*cm, 8.67
to 13.90 in.*lbf) for new bearing
0.49 to 0.78 N*m (5.00 to 7.95 kgf*cm, 4.34
to 6.90 in.*lbf) for reused bearing
Standard preload (Turning torque):
0.61 to 1.35 N*m (20 rpm) at 20°C (6.2 to
13.77 kgf*cm, 5.4 to 11.95 in.*lbf)
HX
HX–90
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE UNIT
HINT:
• If the preload is not within the specified
range, replace the shim with a new one to
adjust the preload.
• Remove the motor side tapered roller
bearing outer race and shim when replacing
the shim.
• Replace the shim and outer race with new
ones if they are deformed or damaged.
• As the shim thickness is increased 0.02 mm
(0.0008 in.), the preload increases
approximately 0.23 N*m (2.4 kgf*cm, 2.04
in.*lbf) accordingly.
Standard shim thickness
HX
Part No.
Thickness
Mark
90564-45040
1.80 mm (0.0709 in.)
1
90564-45041
1.83 mm (0.0720 in.)
2
90564-45042
1.86 mm (0.0732 in.)
3
90564-45043
1.89 mm (0.0744 in.)
4
90564-45071
1.92 mm (0.0756 in.)
50
90564-45072
1.94 mm (0.0764 in.)
51
90564-45073
1.96 mm (0.0722 in.)
52
90564-45074
1.98 mm (0.0780 in.)
53
90564-45075
2.00 mm (0.0787 in.)
54
90564-45076
2.02 mm (0.0795 in.)
55
90564-45077
2.04 mm (0.0803 in.)
56
90564-45078
2.06 mm (0.0811 in.)
57
90564-45079
2.08 mm (0.0819 in.)
58
90564-45080
2.10 mm (0.0827 in.)
59
90564-45081
2.12 mm (0.0835 in.)
60
90564-45082
2.14 mm (0.0843 in.)
61
90564-45083
2.16 mm (0.0850 in.)
62
90564-45084
2.18 mm (0.0858 in.)
63
90564-45085
2.20 mm (0.0866 in.)
64
90564-45086
2.22 mm (0.0874 in.)
65
90564-45087
2.24 mm (0.0882 in.)
66
90564-45088
2.26 mm (0.0890 in.)
67
90564-45089
2.28 mm (0.0898 in.)
68
90564-45090
2.30 mm (0.0906 in.)
69
90564-45091
2.32 mm (0.0913 in.)
70
90564-45060
2.34 mm (0.0921 in.)
19
90564-45061
2.37 mm (0.0933 in.)
20
90564-45011
2.40 mm (0.0945 in.)
No indication
90564-45062
2.43 mm (0.0957 in.)
22
90564-45063
2.46 mm (0.0969 in.)
23
(9) Using an engine sling device and chain block,
remove the 13 bolts and generator.
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE UNIT
HX–91
6.
INSTALL DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION
(a) Install the differential drive pinion.
NOTICE:
• Insert the differential drive pinion vertically.
• Ensure that the differential drive pinion is
fully inserted.
7.
SELECT SHIM
(a) Select the input shaft shim.
(1) Install the No. 1 thrust bearing race.
(2) Apply ATF WS to the sliding surfaces of the
thrust needle roller bearing and install the
flange bearing.
(3) Install the thrust bearing race.
G032107E01
Thrust
Bearing
Race
Thrust Needle Roller Bearing
G031919E01
(4) Install the drive sprocket.
Drive
Sprocket
G031920E01
(5) Install the input shaft.
HX
Input Shaft
G031921E02
(6) Install the No. 1 thrust bearing race.
(7) Apply ATF WS to the sliding surfaces of the
thrust needle roller bearing and install the
flange bearing.
(8) Install the thrust bearing race.
Thrust
Bearing
Race
Thrust Needle Roller Bearing
G031922E01
HX–92
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE UNIT
(9) Install the planetary ring gear.
Planetary
Ring Gear
G031917E01
(10) Install the planetary ring gear flange.
Planetary Ring
Gear Flange
G031918E01
HX
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE UNIT
(11) Using a straightedge and vernier caliper,
measure dimension A as shown in the
illustration.
Standard value:
Dimension A = Measured value - width of
straightedge used
NOTICE:
• Measure dimension A without the shim
installed.
• Take the measurement 3 times each in 3
different locations and use the average
of the measurements taken.
• Two people are required for this step
because it is difficult to keep the
straightedge level. One person should
hold the straightedge, and the other
person measure dimension A.
(12) Using a straightedge and vernier caliper,
measure dimension B as shown in the
illustration.
Standard value:
Dimension B = Measured value - thickness
of straightedge used
NOTICE:
Dimension B is greater than dimension A.
(13) Select a shim.
Standard value:
Select shim = (Dimension B - Dimension
A) - 0.1 mm (0.0039 in.) to 0.4 mm (0.0157
in.)
NOTICE:
Subtract 0.1 mm (0.004 in.) to 0.4 mm (0.016
in.) from the difference of Dimension B and
Dimension A and select a shim on the basis
of the resulting value. This is done because
clearance 0.1 mm (0.004 in.) to 0.4 mm
(0.016 in.) with the input shaft is required.
Standard shim thickness
A
B
C099546E01
HX–93
Part No.
Thickness
Mark
90564-36021
1.00 mm (0.0394 in.)
1
90564-36022
1.20 mm (0.0472 in.)
2
90564-36023
1.40 mm (0.0551 in.)
3
90564-36024
1.60 mm (0.0630 in.)
4
90564-36025
1.80 mm (0.0709 in.)
5
90564-36026
2.00 mm (0.0787 in.)
6
90564-36027
2.20 mm (0.0866 in.)
7
90564-36028
2.40 mm (0.0945 in.)
8
90564-36029
2.60 mm (0.1024 in.)
9
90564-36030
2.80 mm (0.1102 in.)
10
90564-36031
3.00 mm (0.1181 in.)
11
90564-36032
3.20 mm (0.1260 in.)
12
HX
HX–94
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE UNIT
(b) Select a counter drive gear shim.
(1) Install the counter drive gear.
NOTICE:
• Insert the counter drive gear vertically.
• Ensure that the counter drive gear is fully
inserted.
G031916E01
(2) Using a straightedge and vernier caliper,
measure dimension A as shown in the
illustration.
Standard value:
Dimension A = Measured value - width of
straightedge used
NOTICE:
• Measure dimension A without the shim
installed.
• Take the measurement 3 times each in 3
different locations and use the average
of the measurements taken.
• Two people are required for this step
because it is difficult to keep the
straightedge level. One person should
hold the straightedge, and the other
person measure dimension A.
(3) Using a straightedge and vernier caliper,
measure dimension B as shown in the
illustration.
Standard value:
Dimension B = Measured value - thickness
of straightedge used
NOTICE:
Dimension B is greater than dimension A.
(4) Select a shim.
Standard value:
Selected shim = (Dimension B Dimension A) - 0 mm (0 in.) to 0.1 mm
(0.004 in.)
NOTICE:
Subtract 0 mm (0 in.) to 0.1 mm (0.004 in.)
from the difference of Dimension B and
Dimension A and select a shim on the basis
of the resulting value. This is done because
clearance 0 mm (0 in.) to 0.1 mm (0.004 in.)
with the counter drive gear is required.
Standard shim thickness
A
HX
B
C099547E01
Part No.
Thickness
Mark
90564-35132
2.20 mm (0.0866 in.)
A
90564-35133
2.25 mm (0.0886 in.)
B
90564-35134
2.30 mm (0.0906 in.)
C
90564-35135
2.35 mm (0.0925 in.)
D
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE UNIT
Part No.
Thickness
Mark
90564-35136
2.40 mm (0.0945 in.)
E
90564-35137
2.45 mm (0.0965 in.)
F
90564-35138
2.50 mm (0.0984 in.)
G
90564-35139
2.55 mm (0.1003 in.)
H
90564-35140
2.60 mm (0.1024 in.)
J
90564-35141
2.65 mm (0.1043 in.)
K
90564-35142
2.70 mm (0.1063 in.)
L
90564-35143
2.75 mm (0.1083 in.)
M
90564-35144
2.80 mm (0.1102 in.)
N
8.
Shim
HX–95
INSTALL INPUT SHAFT ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the shim selected.
C099548E01
(b) Install the planetary ring gear flange.
(c) Install the thrust bearing race.
(d) Install the thrust needle roller bearing.
(1) Apply ATF WS to the sliding surfaces of the
thrust needle roller bearing and install the
flange.
(e) Install the thrust bearing race.
Thrust
Bearing
Race
Thrust Needle Roller Bearing
C069380E02
(f)
Planetary
Ring Gear
Install the planetary ring gear.
C099549E01
(g) Install the input shaft.
Input Shaft
C099550E02
HX
HX–96
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE UNIT
9.
INSTALL SPROCKET DRIVEN GEAR AND COUNTER
DRIVE GEAR
(a) Install the counter drive gear shim selected.
C099551E01
(b) Install the counter drive gear and chain.
NOTICE:
• Insert the counter drive gear vertically.
• Ensure that the counter drive gear is fully
inserted.
Chain
Counter Drive Gear
C099552E01
10. INSTALL TRANSMISSION DRIVE SPROCKET SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Apply ATF WS auto fluid to the drive sprocket
needle roller bearing and put the drive sprocket on
the chain.
(b) Align the recesses of the planetary ring gear and the
drive sprocket and install the drive sprocket with
chain.
C069385E01
HX
11. INSTALL NO. 2 THRUST BEARING RACE
(a) Install the thrust bearing race.
(b) Install the No. 1 drive sprocket thrust needle roller
bearing.
(1) Apply ATF WS to the sliding surfaces of the
thrust needle roller bearing and install the
bearing.
(c) Install the No. 2 thrust bearing race.
Thrust
Bearing
Race
Thrust Needle Roller Bearing
C069386E01
12. INSTALL TRANSMISSION OIL STRAINER
(a) Apply ATF WS to a new O-ring and install the fluid
strainer.
O-Ring
Transmission
Oil Strainer
C099322E02
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE UNIT
HX–97
(b) Install the oil strainer with the bolt.
Torque: 7.9 N*m (81 kgf*cm, 70 in.*lbf)
C099321E01
FIPG
G031015E01
13. INSTALL HYBRID VEHICLE GENERATOR
ASSEMBLY
(a) Apply seal packing in a continuous line of beads
(diameter 1.5 mm 0.059 in.) to the motor side.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing 1281,
Three Bond 1281 or Equivalent
NOTICE:
• Clean and degrease the installation surfaces.
• Install within 10 minutes of applying seal
packing.
(b) Using an engine sling device and chain block, install
the parking lock rod to the generator so that it is
inserted into the cam guide sleeve.
NOTICE:
Rotate the input shaft in both directions so that
the gears interlock if the generator cannot be
easily installed.
C069392E01
HX
C069022E01
C099316E01
(c) Apply adhesive to the first 2 to 3 threads of the bolt
end.
Adhesive:
Toyota Genuine Adhesive 1344,
Three Bond 1344 or Equivalent
NOTICE:
Clean and degrease the bolt and bolt holes.
(d) Install the 21 bolts as shown in the illustration.
Torque: 25 N*m (250 kgf*cm, 18 ft.*lbf)
HINT:
• 13 bolts on the generator side
HX–98
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE UNIT
• 8 bolts on the motor side
SST
G031016E01
14. INSTALL HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
TYPE T OIL SEAL
(a) Coat the lip of a new oil seal with MP grease.
NOTICE:
Ensure that no foreign objects adhere to the oil
seal lip.
(b) Using SST, tap in oil seal.
Standard depth:
1 to 1.5 mm (0.039 to 0.059 in.)
NOTICE:
Ensure that the oil seal is fitted straight.
15. FIX HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
(a) Set the hybrid transaxle as shown in the illustration.
C099553E01
FIPG
C099554E01
HX
16. INSTALL PARKING COVER
(a) Apply seal packing in a continuous line of beads
(diameter 1.5 mm, 0.06 in.) as shown in the
illustration.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing 1281,
Three Bond 1281 or Equivalent
NOTICE:
• Clean and degrease the installation surfaces.
• Install within 10 minutes of applying seal
packing.
(b) Install the parking shaft cover with the 5 bolts.
Torque: 5.5 N*m (56 kgf*cm, 49 in.*lbf)
C099326E01
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE UNIT
FIPG
G032249E01
HX–99
17. INSTALL MOTOR WATER JACKET COVER
(a) Apply seal packing black in a continuous line of
beads (diameter 1.5 mm, 0.06 in.) as shown in the
illustration.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing 1281,
Three Bond 1281 or Equivalent
NOTICE:
• Clean and degrease the installation surfaces.
• Install within 10 minutes of applying seal
packing.
(b) Apply adhesive to the first 2 to 3 threads of each of
the 6 bolts. Install the motor water jacket cover with
the 6 bolts.
Adhesive:
Toyota Genuine Adhesive 1344,
Three Bond 1344 or Equivalent
Torque: 5.5 N*m (56 kgf*cm, 49 in.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Clean and degrease the bolt and bolt holes.
C069307E01
C069328E01
18. INSTALL TRANSAXLE HOUSING TUBE
CONNECTOR
(a) Apply adhesive to the first 2 to 3 threads of the bolt
and install.
Adhesive:
Toyota Genuine Adhesive 1344,
Three Bond 1344 or Equivalent
Torque: 15 N*m (155 kgf*cm, 11 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Clean and degrease the bolt and bolt holes.
(b) Install the drain plug using a new gasket.
Torque: 39 N*m (400 kgf*cm, 29 ft.*lbf)
19. INSTALL MANUAL DETENT SPRING SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Install the manual detent spring and manual detent
spring cover with the bolt.
Torque: 9.8 N*m (100 kgf*cm, 86 in.*lbf)
Manual Detent Spring
Manual Detent
Spring Cover
C099325E01
HX
HX–100
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE UNIT
FIPG
G031018E01
20. REMOVE PARKING COVER
(a) Apply seal packing in a continuous line of beads
(diameter 1.5 mm, 0.06 in) as shown in the
illustration.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing 1281,
Three Bond 1281 or Equivalent
NOTICE:
• Clean and degrease the installation surfaces.
• Install within 10 minutes of applying seal
packing.
(b) Install the parking cover with the 6 bolts.
Torque: 5.5 N*m (56 kgf*cm, 49 in.*lbf)
C099324E01
21. INSTALL SHIFT CONTROL ACTUATOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Apply a small amount of genuine ATF WS to the Oring.
G030526E01
(b) Install the shift control actuator with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 16 N*m (160 kgf*cm, 12 ft.*lbf)
(c) Install the transmission case cover with the 3 bolts.
HX
C099561E02
22. INSTALL OIL PUMP DRIVE SHAFT
(a) Apply ATF WS to the fluid pump drive shaft and
install it.
C099330E01
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE UNIT
Driven
Rotor
HX–101
23. INSTALL OIL PUMP DRIVEN ROTOR
(a) Apply ATF WS to the fluid pump driven rotor and
install it.
C099329E02
24. INSTALL TRANSAXLE OIL PUMP DRIVE ROTOR
(a) Apply ATF WS to the transaxle fluid pump drive
rotor and install it.
Drive Rotor
C099329E03
25. INSTALL TRANSMISSION OIL PUMP COVER SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Install a new O-ring.
NOTICE:
Ensure that the O-ring is not twisted.
O-Ring
G031019E02
(b) Apply adhesive to the first 2 to 3 threads of the bolt
end.
Adhesive:
Toyota Genuine Adhesive 1344,
Three Bond 1344 or Equivalent
NOTICE:
Clean and degrease the bolts and bolt holes.
(c) Install the oil pump cover with the 5 bolts.
Torque: 5.5 N*m (56 kgf*cm, 49 in.*lbf)
C099328E01
(d) Install a new O-ring and fluid pump cover plug.
O-Ring
C099327E02
HX
HX–102
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE UNIT
26. INSTALL MOTOR STATOR WIRING HARNESS
CONNECTOR
(a) Apply ATF WS to the O-ring and install the motor
stator wiring harness connectors (black) with the
bolt.
Torque: 5.8 N*m (59 kgf*cm, 51 in.*lbf)
Motor Stator Wiring
Harness Connector
G032407E01
27. INSTALL MOTOR REVOLUTION SENSOR WIRING
HARNESS CONNECTOR
(a) Apply ATF WS to the O-ring and install the HV
motor side motor revolution sensor wiring harness
connectors (gray) with the bolt.
Torque: 5.8 N*m (59 kgf*cm, 51 in.*lbf)
Motor Revolution
Sensor Wiring
Harness Connector
G032406E01
28. INSTALL GENERATOR MOTOR REVOLUTION
SENSOR WIRING HARNESS CONNECTOR
(a) Apply ATF WS to the O-ring and install the HV
generator side generator motor revolution sensor
wiring harness connector with the bolt.
Torque: 5.8 N*m (59 kgf*cm, 51 in.*lbf)
C099540E01
HX
B
A
A
A
B
C099539E01
29. INSTALL GENERATOR CABLE
(a) Align the generator cables as shown in the
illustration and connect them.
NOTICE:
• Aligning the letters U, V and W, and connect
the cable.
• Apply a small amount of ATF WS to the Oring.
(b) Apply adhesive to the first 2 or 3 threads of bolts B
and install the generator cable with the bolts.
Torque: 5.8 N*m (59 kgf*cm, 51 in.*lbf) (bolt B)
Adhesive:
Toyota Genuine Adhesive 1344,
Three Bond 1344 or Equivalent
NOTICE:
Clean and degrease the bolts and bolt holes.
(c) Install the generator cable with the 3 bolts (A).
Torque: 8.5 N*m (87 kgf*cm, 75 in.*lbf) (bolt A)
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE UNIT
FIPG
C098385E01
HX–103
30. INSTALL POWER CABLE COVER
(a) Apply seal packing in a continuous line of beads
(diameter 1.5 mm 0.06 in.) as shown in the
illustration.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing 1281,
Three Bond 1281 or Equivalent
NOTICE:
• Clean and degrease the installation surfaces.
• Install within 10 minutes of applying seal
packing.
(b) Apply adhesive to the first 2 or 3 threads of the 4
bolts and install the power cable cover.
Adhesive:
Toyota Genuine Adhesive 1344,
Three Bond 1344 or Equivalent
Torque: 4.8 N*m (49 kgf*cm, 42 in.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Clean and degrease the bolts and bolt holes.
C099335E01
(c) Install the breather plug.
Torque: 11 N*m (112 kgf*cm, 8 ft.*lbf)
C099334E01
31. INSTALL NO. 3 ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET
(a) Apply adhesive to the first 2 or 3 threads of the 3
bolts and install the engine mounting bracket.
Adhesive:
Toyota Genuine Adhesive 1344,
Three Bond 1344 or Equivalent
Torque: 52 N*m (530 kgf*cm, 38 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Clean and degrease the bolts and bolt holes.
G022584E01
32. INSTALL HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
HX
HX–104
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – INPUT SHAFT
INPUT SHAFT
HYBRID SYSTEM
TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE
COMPONENTS
NO. 1 INPUT SHAFT THRUST BEARING RACE
INPUT SHAFT THRUST NEEDLE ROLLER NO. 1 BEARING
INPUT SHAFT ASSEMBLY
HX
NO. 2 INPUT SHAFT THRUST BEARING RACE
PLANETARY SUN GEAR SUB-ASSEMBLY
Apply ATF WS
C130900E01
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – INPUT SHAFT
HX–105
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE PLANETARY SUN GEAR SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the planetary sun gear from the input shaft.
2.
REMOVE INPUT SHAFT THRUST BEARING RACE
(a) Float the input shaft thrust bearing race using a thin
flat-head screwdriver if it is attached to the planetary
sun gear.
C069341E01
C069342E01
(b) Remove the 2 input shaft thrust bearing races and
input shaft thrust needle roller bearing.
Input Shaft
Thrust Needle
Roller Bearing
C069343E01
HX
HX–106
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – INPUT SHAFT
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT PLANETARY SUN GEAR SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Ensure that there is no damage or color change in
the bush.
(b) Using a caliper gauge, inspect the internal diameter
of the planetary gear.
C069344E01
Maximum diameter:
25.596 mm (1.0077 in.)
NOTICE:
Measure the diameter in a number of locations
and use the average of the measurements taken.
HINT:
Replace the planetary sun gear with a new one if
the measurement exceeds the maximum diameter.
C069345E01
2.
HX
INSPECT INPUT SHAFT THRUST NEEDLE ROLLER
NO. 1 BEARING
(a) Ensure that there is no abnormal wear or
discoloration in the bearing.
HINT:
Replace the input shaft thrust needle roller bearing
with a new one if there is abnormal wear or
discoloration.
C069286E01
REASSEMBLY
1.
Input Shaft
Thrust Needle
Roller Bearing
C069343E03
INSTALL INPUT SHAFT THRUST BEARING RACE
(a) Apply ATF WS to the sliding surfaces of the bearing
and install the 2 input shaft thrust bearing races and
input shaft thrust needle roller bearing.
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – INPUT SHAFT
2.
HX–107
INSTALL PLANETARY SUN GEAR SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Apply ATF WS to the bush and install the planetary
sun gear to the input shaft.
C069341E02
HX
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – SPROCKET DRIVEN GEAR AND COUNTER
DRIVE GEAR
HX–107
SPROCKET DRIVEN GEAR AND COUNTER DRIVE GEAR
HYBRID SYSTEM
TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE
COMPONENTS
COUNTER DRIVE GEAR RADIAL BALL BEARING
COUNTER DRIVE GEAR
HX
COUNTER DRIVE GEAR RADIAL BALL BEARING
C130910E01
HX–108
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – SPROCKET DRIVEN GEAR AND COUNTER
DRIVE GEAR
DISASSEMBLY
SST
1.
REMOVE COUNTER DRIVE GEAR RADIAL BALL
BEARING
(a) Using SST and a press, press out the bearing from
the counter drive gear.
SST 09950-00020, 09950-60010 (09951-00330),
09950-70010 (09951-07100)
C069348E01
SST
C069349E02
HX
(b) Using SST and a press, press out the bearing from
the counter drive gear.
SST 09950-00020, 09950-60010 (09951-00330),
09950-70010 (09951-07100)
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – SPROCKET DRIVEN GEAR AND COUNTER
DRIVE GEAR
HX–109
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT COUNTER DRIVE GEAR RADIAL BALL
BEARING
(a) Check the bearing for abnormal wear or
discoloration.
HINT:
Replace the bearing with a new one if abnormal
wear or discoloration is found.
HX
HX–110
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – SPROCKET DRIVEN GEAR AND COUNTER
DRIVE GEAR
REASSEMBLY
1.
SST
INSTALL COUNTER DRIVE GEAR RADIAL BALL
BEARING
(a) Apply ATF WS to the 2 bearings.
(b) Using SST and a press, press in the bearing to the
counter drive gear.
SST 09950-60010 (09951-00330, 09951-00460),
09950-70010 (09951-07100)
C069350E01
SST
SST
C069351E01
HX
(c) Using SST and a press, press in the bearing to the
counter drive gear.
SST 09950-60010 (09951-00330, 09951-00460),
09950-70010 (09951-07100)
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION
HX–109
DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION
HYBRID SYSTEM
TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE
COMPONENTS
COUNTER DRIVE GEAR RADIAL BALL BEARING
280 (2,860, 207)
HX
DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION
COUNTER DRIVE GEAR RADIAL BALL BEARING
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
Apply ATF WS
C130901E01
HX–110
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE COUNTER DRIVE GEAR RADIAL BALL
BEARING
(a) Loosen the staked part of the nut.
C099559E01
(b) Set the differential drive pinion in a vise and remove
the nut using a deep socket wrench.
HINT:
Set the drive pinion in a vise as shown in the
illustration.
G030576E01
(c) Using SST and a press, press out the bearing from
the differential driver pinion.
SST 09527-10011, 09950-00020, 09950-60010
(09951-00360), 09950-70010 (09951-07100)
SST
HX
G030577E01
SST
G030578E01
(d) Using SST and a press, press out the bearing from
the differential drive pinion.
SST 09527-10011, 09950-00020, 09950-60010
(09951-00360), 09950-70010 (09951-07100)
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – DIFFERENTIAL DRIVE PINION
HX–111
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT COUNTER DRIVE GEAR RADIAL BALL
BEARING
(a) Check the bearing for abnormal wear or
discoloration.
HINT:
Replace the bearing with a new one if abnormal
wear or discoloration is found.
REASSEMBLY
1.
SST
INSTALL COUNTER DRIVE GEAR RADIAL BALL
BEARING
(a) Using SST and a press, press in the bearing to the
differential drive pinion.
SST 09608-06041
G030579E01
SST
(b) Using SST and a press, press in the bearing to the
differential drive pinion.
SST 09608-06041, 09950-60010 (09951-00370)
G030580E01
(c) Set the differential drive pinion in a vise and tighten
a new nut using a deep socket wrench.
Torque: 280 N*m (2,860 kgf*cm, 207 ft.*lbf)
HINT:
Set the vise as shown in the illustration.
G030576E01
(d) Stake the nut.
C099559E01
HX
HX–112
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – TRANSMISSION DRIVE SPROCKET
TRANSMISSION DRIVE SPROCKET
HYBRID SYSTEM
TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE
COMPONENTS
SNAP RING
SPACER
HX
NO. 2 DRIVE SPROCKET NEEDLE ROLLER BEARING
TRANSMISSION DRIVE SPROCKET SUB-ASSEMBLY
Apply ATF WS
C130902E01
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – TRANSMISSION DRIVE SPROCKET
HX–113
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE TRANSMISSION DRIVE SPROCKET SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Using a thin screwdriver, pry out the snap ring from
the transmission drive sprocket.
C069346E01
(b) Remove the spacer and the needle roller bearing
from the transmission drive sprocket.
C069347E01
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT NO. 2 DRIVE SPROCKET NEEDLE ROLLER
BEARING
(a) Check the bearing for abnormal wear or
discoloration.
HINT:
Replace the needle roller bearing with a new one if
abnormal wear or discoloration is found.
C069285E01
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL TRANSMISSION DRIVE SPROCKET SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Apply ATF WS to the sliding surfaces of the bearing
and install the needle roller bearing to the
transmission drive sprocket.
(b) Install the spacer to the transmission drive sprocket.
C069347E01
(c) Using a thin screwdriver, install the snap ring to the
transmission drive sprocket.
C069346E01
HX
HX–114
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – DIFFERENTIAL CASE
DIFFERENTIAL CASE
HYBRID SYSTEM
TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE
COMPONENTS
DIFFERENTIAL CASE RH TAPERED ROLLER BEARING
DIFFERENTIAL CASE
DIFFERENTIAL CASE LH
TAPERED ROLLER BEARING
PINION THRUST WASHER
SIDE GEAR
SIDE GEAR THRUST WASHER
PINION GEAR
HX
SIDE GEAR
PINION SHAFT
PINION GEAR
PINION THRUST WASHER
SIDE GEAR THRUST WASHER
STRAIGHT PIN
Apply ATF WS
C130903E01
HX–115
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – DIFFERENTIAL CASE
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL CASE LH TAPERED
ROLLER BEARING
(a) Set the differential case in a vise.
(b) Using SST, remove the bearing RH from the
differential case.
SST 09950-40011 (09951-04010, 09952-04010,
09953-04020, 09954-04010, 09955-04061,
09958-04010)
NOTICE:
Apply oil or equivalent to the ends and screw
portions of SST.
2.
REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL CASE RH TAPERED
ROLLER BEARING
(a) Set the differential case in a vise.
(b) Using SST, remove the bearing LH from the
differential case.
SST 09950-40011 (09951-04010, 09952-04010,
09953-04020, 09954-04010, 09955-04061,
09958-04010)
3.
REMOVE DIFFERENTIAL CASE
(a) Set the differential case in a vise.
(b) Tap out the straight pin from the differential case
with a 5 mm pin punch.
SST
C069352E01
SST
C069353E01
C069354E01
(c) Remove the following parts from the differential
case.
3
2
5
4
5
4
1
2
3
C069283E01
Number
Part
Number of Parts
1
Pinion shaft
1
2
Pinion
2
3
Pinion thrust washer
2
4
Side gear
2
5
Side gear thrust washer
2
HX
HX–116
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – DIFFERENTIAL CASE
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT DIFFERENTIAL CASE TAPERED ROLLER
BEARING
(a) Check the bearing for abnormal wear or
discoloration.
HINT:
Replace the bearing with a new one if abnormal
wear or discoloration is found.
REASSEMBLY
1.
C069355E01
C069418E01
HX
INSTALL DIFFERENTIAL CASE
(a) Apply ATF WS to the side gear thrust washer and
install it to the side gear.
(b) Apply ATF WS to the side gear thrust washer and
install it to the pinion.
(c) Install the side gear and pinion to the differential
case.
(d) Install the pinion shaft to the differential case so that
the straight pin holes of the pinion shaft and
differential case are aligned.
(e) Set the pinion side and inspect the side gear
backlash.
Standard backlash:
0.05 to 0.20 mm (0.0020 to 0.0079 in.)
HINT:
• Replace the side gear thrust washers with the
same size for both the right and left side gears if
the value is outside the specified range.
• Ensure that rotation is smooth if side gear
backlash is within the specified range.
If the backlash exceeds the specified range, replace
the side gear thrust washer with thinner one.
If the backlash is less then the specified range,
replace the side gear thrust washer with thicker one.
Standard side gear thrust washer thickness
Part No.
Washer thickness
41361-22140
0.95 mm (0.0374 in.)
41361-22020
1.00 mm (0.0394 in.)
41361-22150
1.05 mm (0.0414 in.)
41361-22030
1.10 mm (0.0433 in.)
41361-22160
1.15 mm (0.0453 in.)
41361-22040
1.20 mm (0.0472 in.)
(f)
C069356E01
Using a 5 mm pin punch, tap in the straight pin to
the differential case.
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – DIFFERENTIAL CASE
HX–117
(g) Using a chisel, caulk the external circumference of
the differential case straight pin hole.
C069019E01
2.
INSTALL DIFFERENTIAL CASE RH TAPERED
ROLLER BEARING
(a) Using SST and a press, press in the bearing RH to
the differential case.
SST 09710-22021 (09710-01031), 09950-70010
(09951-07100)
HINT:
There are 24 bearing rollers in bearing RH.
3.
INSTALL DIFFERENTIAL CASE LH TAPERED
ROLLER BEARING
(a) Using SST and a press, press in the bearing LH to
the differential case.
SST 09710-22021 (09710-01031), 09950-70010
(09951-07100)
HINT:
There are 22 bearing rollers in bearing LH.
SST
C069357E01
SST
C069358E01
HX
HX–118
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – GENERATOR CABLE
GENERATOR CABLE
REMOVAL
CAUTION:
• When working on the high voltage systems, always
wear insulated gloves.
• Keep the removed service plug in your pocket to
prevent other technicians from reconnecting it while
you are servicing the vehicle.
• After removing the service plug grip, do not touch the
high voltage connectors and terminals for 5 minutes.
NOTICE:
After removing the service plug grip, do not operate the
power switch as it may damage the hybrid vehicle
control ECU.
HX
G021868E01
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE SERVICE PLUG GRIP
(a) Remove the service plug grip (see page HB-153).
3.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
4.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
5.
DRAIN COOLANT
(a) Drain coolant (see page HX-58).
6.
REMOVE FRONT COWL TOP PANEL OUTER SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the cowl top front panel (see page FU-12).
7.
REMOVE INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the inverter with converter (see page HV530).
8.
REMOVE GENERATOR CABLE
(a) Check that there is no voltage.
CAUTION:
Ensure that insulated gloves are worn when
carrying out this procedure.
(1) Remove the 4 bolts and power cable cover.
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – GENERATOR CABLE
HX–119
(2) Remove the 2 bolts from the generator cable.
C098381E01
(3) Inspect the voltage between each of the 3
phase AC terminals (U to V, V to W, U to W)
and body ground using the Toyota electrical
tester.
Standard value:
0V
HINT:
Use the Toyota Electrical Tester on measured
ranges of DC 400 volts or more.
C098382E01
(b) Remove the 3 bolts and generator cable.
C098383E01
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL GENERATOR CABLE
(a) Apply a small amount of ATF WS to the generator
cable's O-ring.
G030264E01
(b) Connect the generator cable as shown in the
illustration.
NOTICE:
• Align the letters U, V and W, and connect the
cable.
• Ensure that no foreign objects are attached to
the O-ring when connecting the cables.
C098382E01
HX
HX–120
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – GENERATOR CABLE
(c) Install the generator cable (terminals) with the 3
bolts.
Torque: 8.5 N*m (87 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
C098383E01
(d) Install the generator cable with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 5.8 N*m (59 kgf*cm, 51 in.*lbf)
C098381E01
(e) Apply seal packing in a continuous line of beads
(diameter 1.5 mm (0.059 in.) to the power cable
cover.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing 1281,
Three Bond 1281 or Equivalent
NOTICE:
• Clean and degrease the installation surfaces.
• Install within 10 minutes of applying seal
packing.
• Ensure that no foreign objects are inserted
when the power cable cover is attached.
FIPG
C098385E01
HX
(f)
G021868E01
Install the power cable cover with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 4.8 N*m (49 kgf*cm, 42 in.*lbf)
2.
INSTALL INVERTER WITH CONVERTER ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the inverter with converter (see page HV535).
3.
INSTALL FRONT COWL TOP PANEL OUTER SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Install the cowl top front panel (see page FU-19).
4.
INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
5.
INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
6.
INSTALL SERVICE PLUG GRIP
(a) Install the service plug grip (see page HB-154).
7.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
8.
ADD COOLANT
(a) Add coolant (see page HX-58).
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – GENERATOR CABLE
9.
HX–121
CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS
(a) Check for engine coolant leaks (see page CO-9).
10. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
HX
HX–122
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – SHIFT LEVER
SHIFT LEVER
HYBRID SYSTEM
TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE
COMPONENTS
NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER ASSEMBLY
UPPER INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
NO. 3 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER ASSEMBLY
SHIFT LEVER ASSEMBLY
12 (122, 9)
HX
LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C130905E01
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – SHIFT LEVER
HX–123
INDICATOR LIGHT WIRE SUB-ASSEMBLY
SHIFT LOCK CONTROL UNIT
CAP
BULB
HX
COVER
C130906E01
HX–124
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – SHIFT LEVER
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-5)
2.
REMOVE LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page IP-6)
3.
REMOVE UPPER INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page IP-6)
4.
REMOVE NO. 3 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-6)
5.
REMOVE SHIFT LEVER ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 3 bolts.
(b) Disconnect the 2 connectors and remove the shift
lever.
G021871E01
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE INDICATOR LIGHT WIRE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the position indicator light wire from the
position indicator housing.
HX
G022473E01
(b) Remove the cover.
(c) Disconnect the connector from the 3 clamps and
remove the position indicator light wire.
G032250E01
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – SHIFT LEVER
HX–125
(d) Remove the bulb and cap from the position indicator
light wire.
C097950E01
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL INDICATOR LIGHT WIRE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the bulb and cap to the position indicator light
wire.
C097950E01
(b) Connect the connector to the 3 clamps.
(c) Install the cover.
HX
G032250E01
(d) Install the position indicator light wire to the position
indicator housing.
NOTICE:
Securely attach the wire by twisting to the right.
G022473E01
HX–126
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – SHIFT LEVER
INSTALLATION
G021871E01
HX
1.
INSTALL SHIFT LEVER ASSEMBLY
(a) Connect the 2 connectors to the shift lever.
(b) Install the shift lever with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 12 N*m (122 kgf*cm, 9 ft.*lbf)
2.
INSPECT SHIFT LEVER ASSEMBLY
(a) Inspect the shift lever (see page HX-2).
3.
INSTALL NO. 3 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-13)
4.
INSTALL UPPER INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page IP-13)
5.
INSTALL LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page IP-13)
6.
INSTALL NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-13)
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – OIL PUMP DRIVE SHAFT
HX–127
OIL PUMP DRIVE SHAFT
HYBRID SYSTEM
TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE
COMPONENTS
OIL PUMP DRIVE SHAFT
x5
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
HX
OIL PUMP DRIVEN ROTOR
TRANSAXLE OIL PUMP DRIVE ROTOR
O-RING
TRANSMISSION OIL PUMP COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
Apply ATF WS
C130907E01
HX–128
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – OIL PUMP DRIVE SHAFT
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL LH
2.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
3.
DRAIN TRANSAXLE OIL
(a) Drain transaxle oil (see page HX-1).
4.
REMOVE TRANSMISSION OIL PUMP COVER SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 5 bolts and oil pump cover.
C069315E01
(b) Remove the O-ring.
O-Ring
G031019E02
5.
REMOVE TRANSAXLE OIL PUMP DRIVE ROTOR
(a) Remove the transaxle oil pump drive rotor from the
hybrid vehicle transaxle.
6.
REMOVE OIL PUMP DRIVEN ROTOR
(a) Remove the oil pump driven rotor from the hybrid
vehicle transaxle.
HX
Drive Rotor
C099329E03
Driven
Rotor
C099329E02
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – OIL PUMP DRIVE SHAFT
7.
HX–129
REMOVE OIL PUMP DRIVE SHAFT
(a) Remove the oil pump drive shaft from the hybrid
vehicle transaxle.
C069318E01
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL OIL PUMP DRIVE SHAFT
(a) Apply ATF WS to the oil pump drive shaft and install
it to the hybrid vehicle transaxle.
HINT:
Use genuine ATF WS.
2.
INSTALL OIL PUMP DRIVEN ROTOR
(a) Apply ATF WS to the oil pump driven rotor and
install it to the hybrid vehicle transaxle.
HINT:
Use genuine ATF WS.
3.
INSTALL TRANSAXLE OIL PUMP DRIVE ROTOR
(a) Apply ATF WS to the oil pump drive rotor and install
it to the hybrid vehicle transaxle.
HINT:
Use genuine ATF WS.
C069318E01
Driven
Rotor
C099329E02
Drive Rotor
C099329E03
4.
O-ring
G031019E01
INSTALL TRANSMISSION OIL PUMP COVER SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Install a new O-ring to the hybrid transaxle.
NOTICE:
Do not twist the O-ring when installing it.
HX
HX–130
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – OIL PUMP DRIVE SHAFT
(b) Apply adhesive to the first 2 or 3 threads of the bolt
end.
Adhesive:
Toyota Genuine Adhesive 1344,
Three Bond 1344 or Equivalent
NOTICE:
Clean and degrease the bolts and bolt holes.
(c) Install the oil pump cover with the 5 bolts.
Torque: 5.5 N*m (56 kgf*cm, 49 in.*lbf)
C069315E01
HX
5.
INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
6.
ADD TRANSAXLE OIL
Fluid type:
Toyota genuine ATF WS
Standard capacity:
3.8 liters (4.0 US qts, 3.3 Imp. qts)
7.
INSPECT TRANSAXLE OIL
(a) Inspect transaxle oil (see page HX-1).
8.
INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID TRANSAXLE OIL SEAL
HX–131
HYBRID TRANSAXLE OIL SEAL
HYBRID SYSTEM
TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE
COMPONENTS
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT HOLE SNAP RING
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY RH
HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE OIL SEAL
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY LH
FRONT SPEED SENSOR LH
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
CLIP
29 (296, 21)
49 (500, 36)
HX
TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
216 (2,203, 159)
89 (908, 66)
FRONT AXLE HUB NUT LH
ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
C130904E01
HX–132
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID TRANSAXLE OIL SEAL
REPLACEMENT
1.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
2.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
3.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
4.
DRAIN TRANSAXLE OIL
(a) Drain transaxle oil (see page HX-1).
5.
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the drive shaft (see page DS-7).
6.
REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Remove the drive shaft (see page DS-7).
7.
REMOVE HYBRID TRANSAXLE OIL SEAL
(a) Using SST, tap out the oil seal.
SST 09308-00010
8.
INSTALL HYBRID TRANSAXLE OIL SEAL
(a) Apply a small amount of No. 2 MP grease to the lip
of a new oil seal.
(b) Using SST, tap in the oil seal to the standard depth.
Standard depth:
2.7 +-0.5 mm (0.106 +-0.020 in.)
SST 09950-70010 (09951-07200), 09350-32014
(09351-32130, 09351-32150)
9.
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Install the front drive shaft (see page DS-15).
SST
G021806E01
SST
HX
G021807E01
10. INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the front drive shaft (see page DS-15).
11. INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
12. ADD TRANSAXLE OIL
Fluid type:
Toyota genuine ATF WS
Capacity:
3.8 liters (4.0 US qts, 3.3 Imp. qts)
13. INSPECT TRANSAXLE OIL
(a) Inspect the transaxle oil level (see page HX-1).
14. INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
15. INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
16. INSPECT AND ADJUST FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
(a) Inspect and adjust the front wheel alignment (see
page SP-2).
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – HYBRID TRANSAXLE OIL SEAL
HX–133
17. PERFORM CALIBRATION
(a) Perform calibration (see page PS-13).
HX
HX–134
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – INPUT SHAFT OIL SEAL
INPUT SHAFT OIL SEAL
HYBRID SYSTEM
TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE
COMPONENTS
HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
HX
INPUT SHAFT OIL SEAL
Non-reusable part
C130908E01
HYBRID TRANSMISSION / TRANSAXLE – INPUT SHAFT OIL SEAL
HX–135
REPLACEMENT
CAUTION:
• When working on the high voltage systems, always
wear insulated gloves.
• Keep the removed service plug in your pocket to
prevent other technicians from reconnecting it while
you are servicing the vehicle.
• After removing the service plug grip, do not touch the
high voltage connectors and terminals for 5 minutes.
NOTICE:
After removing the service plug grip, do not operate the
power switch as it may damage the hybrid vehicle
control ECU.
1.
REMOVE HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE
ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the hybrid vehicle transaxle (see page HX66).
2.
REMOVE INPUT SHAFT OIL SEAL
(a) Insert a flat-head screwdriver into the metal portion
of the oil seal and pry out the oil seal.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the input shaft and transaxle
housing when inserting the screwdriver or
removing the oil seal.
3.
INSTALL INPUT SHAFT OIL SEAL
(a) Apply a small amount of No. 2 MP grease to the lip
of a new oil seal.
(b) Using SST, install the oil seal.
SST 09388-40010
Standard depth:
1.0 to 1.5 mm (0.039 to 0.059 in.)
NOTICE:
• Ensure that no foreign objects adhere to the
oil seal lip.
• Ensure that the oil seal is not at an angle.
C069360E01
SST
G031020E01
4.
INSTALL HYBRID VEHICLE TRANSAXLE ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the hybrid vehicle transaxle (see page HX70).
HX
IG–1
1NZ-FXE IGNITION – IGNITION SYSTEM
IGNITION SYSTEM
1NZ-FXE IGNITION
ENGINE
PARTS LOCATION
POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU
ECM
FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK
- MAIN H-FUSE
IG
ENGINE ROOM RELAY BLOCK, JUNCTION BLOCK
- INTEGRATION RELAY (UNIT B: IG2 RELAY)
- AM2 FUSE
- P/I FUSE
IGNITION COIL ASSEMBLY
(WITH IGNITER)
CAMSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
SPARK PLUG
CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR
A124644E01
IG–2
1NZ-FXE IGNITION – IGNITION SYSTEM
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
No. 1 Ignition Coil
+B
IGT
ECM
IGT1
Spark Plug
IGF
IGF
GND
No. 2 Ignition Coil
IG2D
IG2
AM2
Power
Source
Control
ECU
Spark Plug
+B
IGT
GND
IGF
IGT2
No. 3 Ignition Coil
INTEGRATION RELAY
(UNIT B)
Spark Plug +B
IGT
GND
IG
IGT3
IGF
No. 4 Ignition Coil
AM2
Spark Plug
IGT
GND
IGF
IGT4
Camshaft Position Sensor
P/I
Noise
Filter
MAIN
+B
G2+
Shielded
Crankshaft Position Sensor
NE+
NEShielded
E1
A124654E01
1NZ-FXE IGNITION – IGNITION SYSTEM
IG–3
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
NOTICE:
In this section, the terms "cold" and "hot" refer to the
temperature of the coils. "Cold" means approximately 10 to 50°C (14 to 122°F). "Hot" means approximately 50 to
100°C (122 to 212°F).
1.
PERFORM SPARK TEST
(a) Check for DTCs (see page ES-29).
NOTICE:
If a DTC is present, perform troubleshooting in
accordance with the procedure for that DTC.
(b) Check that sparks occur.
(1) Remove the ignition coil (see page IG-8).
(2) Disconnect the 4 fuel injector connectors.
A126793
16 mm Plug Wrench
(3) Using a 16 mm plug wrench, remove the 4
spark plugs.
Torque: 18 N*m (184 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
A126794E01
A126795
(4) Install each spark plug into an ignition coil, then
connect the ignition coil connectors.
(5) Ground the spark plug.
(6) Check that sparks occur at each spark plug
while the engine is being cranked.
NOTICE:
• Be sure to ground the spark plugs when
checking them.
• If the ignition coil has been struck or
dropped, replace it.
• Do not crank the engine for more than 2
seconds.
If sparks do not occur, perform the following
procedure.
IG
IG–4
1NZ-FXE IGNITION – IGNITION SYSTEM
(c) Spark test flow chart.
(1) Check that the wire harness side connector of
the ignition coil is securely connected.
Result
Result
Proceed to
NG
Connect securely
OK
Go to next step
(2) Perform the spark test on each ignition coil.
1. Replace the ignition coil with a normal one.
2. Perform the spark test again.
Result
Result
Proceed to
OK
Replace ignition coil
NG
Go to next step
(3) Check power supply to the ignition coil.
1. Disconnect the ignition coil connector.
2. Turn the ignition switch ON.
3. Using a voltmeter, measure the voltage
between the terminals.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1 (+B) - 4 (GND)
9.0 to 14 V
IG
Result
Result
Proceed to
NG
Check wire harness and connector
(Between power switch and ignition
coil assembly)
OK
Go to next step
A126796
(4) Check the resistance of the camshaft position
sensor.
Standard resistance
Temperature
Specified Condition
Cold
1,630 to 2,740 Ω
Hot
1,060 to 1,645 Ω
Result
Result
Proceed to
NG
Replace camshaft position sensor
OK
Go to next step
(5) Check the resistance of the crankshaft position
sensor.
Standard resistance
Temperature
Specified Condition
Cold
985 to 1,600 Ω
Hot
1,265 to 1,890 Ω
Result
Result
Proceed to
NG
Replace crankshaft position sensor
IG–5
1NZ-FXE IGNITION – IGNITION SYSTEM
Result
Proceed to
OK
Go to next step
(6) Check IGT signal from the ECM.
Result
Result
Proceed to
NG
Replace ECM
OK
Repair wire harness or connector
(Between ignition coil assembly and
ignition switch)
2.
Ground
I039522E10
CHECK SPARK PLUG
(a) Check the electrode.
(1) Using a megohmmeter, measure the insulation
resistance.
Standard insulation resistance:
10 MΩ or more
HINT:
• If a megohmmeter is not available, perform
the following simple inspection instead.
• If the result is 10 MΩ or less, clean the plug
and measure the resistance again.
(b) Alternative inspection method:
(1) Quickly accelerate the engine to 4,000 rpm 5
times.
(2) Remove the spark plug.
(3) Visually check the spark plug.
If the electrode is dry, the spark plug is
functioning properly. If the electrode is damp,
proceed to the next step.
(c) Check the spark plug for any damage on its thread
and insulator.
If there is damage, replace the spark plug.
Recommended spark plug
A126881
Manufacturer
Product
DENSO
SK16R11
NGK
IFR5A11
(d) Check the spark plug electrode gap.
Maximum electrode gap for used spark plug:
1.3 mm (0.051 in.)
If the gap is greater than the maximum, replace the
spark plug.
Electrode gap for new spark plug:
1.0 to 1.1 mm (0.039 to 0.043 in.)
1.0 to 1.1 mm
A126880E01
IG
IG–6
1NZ-FXE IGNITION – IGNITION SYSTEM
B062019E01
IG
(e) Clean the spark plugs.
If the electrode has traces of wet carbon, clean the
electrode with a spark plug cleaner and then dry it.
Standard air pressure:
588 kPa (6 kgf*cm2, 85 psi)
Standard duration:
20 seconds or less
HINT:
Only use the spark plug cleaner when the electrode
is free of oil. If the electrode has traces of oil, use
gasoline to clean off the oil before using the spark
plug cleaner.
1NZ-FXE IGNITION – IGNITION COIL
IG–7
IGNITION COIL
1NZ-FXE IGNITION
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
ENGINE ROOM NO. 2 RELAY BLOCK
IGNITION COIL CONNECTOR
9.0 (90, 80 in.*lbf)
IGNITION COIL ASSEMBLY
8.4 (86, 74 in.*lbf)
IG
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A125340E01
IG–8
1NZ-FXE IGNITION – IGNITION COIL
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
2.
REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-4)
3.
REMOVE REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
4.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
5.
DISCONNECT ENGINE ROOM NO. 2 RELAY BLOCK
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and disconnect the relay block.
6.
REMOVE IGNITION COIL ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the 4 ignition coil connectors.
A087417E01
IG
(b) Remove the 4 bolts and pull out the 4 ignition coils.
A126797
INSTALLATION
1.
A126797
INSTALL IGNITION COIL ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the 4 ignition coils with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 9.0 N*m (90 kgf*cm, 80 in.*lbf)
(b) Connect the 4 ignition coil connectors.
1NZ-FXE IGNITION – IGNITION COIL
IG–9
2.
INSTALL ENGINE ROOM NO. 2 RELAY BLOCK
(a) Install the relay block with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 8.4 N*m (86 kgf*cm, 74 ft.*lbf)
3.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
4.
INSTALL REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
5.
INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-8)
6.
INSTALL REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
7.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
A087417E01
IG
INTRODUCTION – HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
IN–1
HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
GENERAL INFORMATION
1.
2.
3.
4.
GENERAL DESCRIPTION
(a) This manual is written in accordance with SAE
J2008.
(1) Diagnosis
(2) Removing / Installing, Replacing, Disassembling
/ Reassembling, Checking and Adjusting
(3) Final Inspection
(b) The following procedures are omitted from this
manual. However, these procedures must be
performed.
(1) Use a jack or lift to perform operations.
(2) Clean all removed parts.
(3) Perform a visual check.
INDEX
(a) An alphabetical INDEX section is provided at the
end of the manual as a reference to help you find
the item to be repaired.
PREPARATION
(a) Use of Special Service Tools (SST) and Special
Service Materials (SSM) may be required,
depending on the repair procedure. Be sure to use
SST and SSM when they are required and follow
the working procedures properly. A list of SST and
SSM is in the "Preparation" section of this manual.
REPAIR PROCEDURES
(a) A component illustration is placed under the title
where necessary.
IN
IN–2
INTRODUCTION – HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
(b) Non-reusable parts, grease application areas,
precoated parts and torque specifications are noted
in the component illustrations.
The following illustration is an example.
IN
Example:
Filter Cap
Float
Clevis Pin
GASKET
Reservoir Tank
Slotted Spring Pin
Clip
Washer
Grommet
Clevis
12 (120, 9)
Boot
15 (155, 11)
Lock Nut
Snap Ring
Push Rod
Cylinder
Piston
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
D100720E01
(c) Torque specifications, grease application areas and
non-reusable parts are emphasized in the
procedures.
HINT:
There are cases where such information can only
be explained by using an illustration. In these cases,
torque, oil and other information are described in the
illustration.
(d) Only items with key points are described in the text.
What to do and other details are explained using
illustrations next to the text. Both the text and
illustrations are accompanied by standard values
and notices.
Illustration
What to do and where to do it
Task heading
What work will be performed
Explanation text
•
•
5.
How to perform the task
Information such as specifications and warnings, which are written
in boldface text
(e) Illustrations of similar vehicle models are sometimes
used. In these cases, minor details may be different
from the actual vehicle.
(f) Procedures are presented in a step-by-step format.
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS
(a) SPECIFICATIONS are presented in boldface text
throughout the manual. The specifications are also
found in the "Service Specifications" section for
reference.
INTRODUCTION – HOW TO USE THIS MANUAL
6.
TERM DEFINITIONS
CAUTION
Possibility of injury to you or other people.
NOTICE
Possibility of damage to components being repaired.
HINT
Provides additional information to help you perform repairs.
7.
IN–3
INTERNATIONAL SYSTEM OF UNITS
(a) The units used in this manual comply with the
International System of Units (SI) standard. Units
from the metric system and English system are also
provided.
Example:
Torque: 30 N*m (310 kgf*cm, 22 ft.*lbf)
IN
IN–4
INTRODUCTION – IDENTIFICATION INFORMATION
IDENTIFICATION INFORMATION
Vehicle Identification Number Plate
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION AND
SERIAL NUMBERS
IN
Certification
Label
1.
VEHICLE IDENTIFICATION NUMBER
(a) The vehicle identification number is stamped on the
vehicle identification number plate and on the
certification label, as shown in the illustration.
(1) Vehicle Identification Number Plate
(2) Certification Label
2.
ENGINE SERIAL NUMBER AND TRANSMISSION
SERIAL NUMBER
(a) The engine serial number is stamped on the
cylinder block of the engine and the motor serial
number is stamped on the motor as shown in the
illustration.
(1) Engine serial number is stamped on the cylinder
block of the engine.
(2) Motor serial number is stamped on the motor.
D100872E01
Engine
Serial
Number
Motor Serial Number
D100873E01
IN–5
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
REPAIR INSTRUCTION
PRECAUTION
1.
BASIC REPAIR HINT
(a) HINTS ON OPERATIONS
IN
2
1
5
3
3
6
4
D100874E01
1
Attire
•
•
2
Vehicle protection
Prepare a grille cover, fender cover, seat cover and floor mat before starting the
operation.
3
Safe operation
•
•
•
•
•
Always wear a clean uniform.
A hat and safety shoes must be worn.
When working with 2 or more persons, be sure to check safety for one another.
When working with the engine running, make sure to provide ventilation for exhaust
fumes in the workshop.
If working on high temperature, high pressure, rotating, moving, or vibrating parts,
wear appropriate safety equipment and take extra care not to injure yourself or
others.
When jacking up the vehicle, be sure to support the specified location with a safety
stand.
When lifting up the vehicle, use appropriate safety equipment.
4
Preparation of tools and
measuring gauge
Before starting the operation, prepare a tool stand, SST, gauge, oil and parts for
replacement.
5
Removal and installation,
disassembly and assembly
operations
•
•
•
•
Diagnose with a thorough understanding of proper procedures and of the reported
problem.
Before removing parts, check the general condition of the assembly and for
deformation and damage.
When the assembly is complicated, take notes. For example, note the total number of
electrical connections, bolts, or hoses removed. Add matchmarks to ensure
reassembly of components to their original positions. Temporarily mark hoses and
their fittings if needed.
Clean and wash the removed parts if necessary and assemble them after a thorough
check.
IN–6
6
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
Removed parts
•
•
•
Place removed parts in a separate box to avoid mixing them up with new parts or
contaminating new parts.
For non-reusable parts such as gaskets, O-rings, and self-locking nuts, replace them
with new ones as instructed in this manual.
Retain the removed parts for customer inspection, if requested.
(b) JACKING UP AND SUPPORTING VEHICLE
(1) Care must be taken when jacking up and
supporting the vehicle. Be sure to lift and
support the vehicle at the proper locations.
IN
Seal Lock Adhesive
D100721E01
(c) PRECOATED PARTS
(1) Precoated parts are bolts and nuts that are
coated with a seal lock adhesive at the factory.
(2) If a precoated part is retightened, loosened or
moved in any way, it must be recoated with the
specified adhesive.
(3) When reusing a precoated part, clean off the old
adhesive and dry the part with compressed air.
Then apply new seal lock adhesive appropriate
to that part.
(4) Some seal lock agents harden slowly. You may
have to wait for the seal lock adhesive to
harden.
(d) GASKETS
(1) When necessary, use a sealer on gaskets to
prevent leaks.
(e) BOLTS, NUTS AND SCREWS
(1) Carefully follow all the specifications for
tightening torques. Always use a torque wrench.
(f)
INCORRECT
CORRECT
FUSES
(1) When inspecting a fuse, check that the wire of
the fuse is not broken.
(2) When replacing fuses, be sure that the new fuse
has the correct amperage rating. Do not exceed
the rating or use one with a lower rating.
D100722E01
Illustration
Symbol
Part Name
Abbreviation
FUSE
FUSE
MEDIUM CURRENT FUSE
M-FUSE
IN–7
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
Illustration
Symbol
Part Name
Abbreviation
HIGH CURRENT FUSE
H-FUSE
FUSIBLE LINK
FL
CIRCUIT BREAKER
CB
(g) CLIPS
(1) The removal and installation methods of typical
clips used for vehicle body parts are shown in
the table below.
HINT:
If clips are damaged during a procedure, always
replace the clips with new clips.
Shape (Example)
Illustration
Procedures
1. Remove the clips with a clip remover or
pliers.
1. Remove the clips with a clip remover or
screwdriver.
IN
IN–8
Shape (Example)
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
Illustration
Procedures
1. Remove the clips with a wide scraper to
prevent panel damage.
IN
1. Remove the clips by pushing center pin
through and prying out the shell.
1. Remove the clips by unscrewing the
center pin and prying out the shell.
1. Remove the clips by prying out the pin
and then prying out the shell.
(h) CLAWS
(1) The removal and installation methods of typical
claws used for vehicle body parts are shown in
the table below.
HINT:
If claws of caps or covers are damaged during a
procedure, always replace the caps or covers
with new ones.
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
Shape (Example)
Illustration
IN–9
Procedures
1. Using a screwdriver, detach the claws
and remove the cap or cover.
IN
1. Using a screwdriver, detach the claws
and remove the cap or cover.
1. Using a screwdriver, detach the claws
and remove the cap or cover.
(i)
INCORRECT
CORRECT
D100723E01
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION OF VACUUM
HOSES
(1) To disconnect a vacuum hose, pull and twist
from the end of the hose. Do not pull from the
middle of the hose as this may cause damage.
IN–10
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
(2) When disconnecting vacuum hoses, use tags to
identify where they should be reconnected.
(3) After completing any hose related repairs,
double check that the vacuum hoses are
properly connected. The label under the hood
shows the proper layout.
(4) When using a vacuum gauge, never force the
hose onto a connector that is too large. If a hose
has been stretched, it may leak air. Use a stepdown adapter if necessary.
IN
D100724
(j)
TORQUE WHEN USING TORQUE WRENCH
WITH EXTENSION TOOL
L2
L1
D100725E01
L1
(1) Use the formula below to calculate special
torque values for situations where SST or an
extension tool is combined with the torque
wrench.
Formula:
T' = L2 / (L1 + L2) * T
L2
T'
D100726E01
Reading of torque wrench {N*m
(kgf*cm, ft.*lbf)}
T
Torque {N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf)}
L1
Length of SST or extension tool {cm
(in.)}
L2
Length of torque wrench {cm (in.)}
2.
NOTICE:
If an extension tool or SST is combined with
a torque wrench and the wrench is used to
tighten to a torque specification in this
manual, the actual torque will be excessive
and parts will be damaged.
PRECAUTIONS FOR HIGH-VOLTAGE CIRCUIT
INSPECTION AND SERVICE
(a) Engineers must undergo special training to be able
to perform high-voltage system inspection and
servicing.
(b) All high-voltage wire harness connectors are
colored orange. The HV battery and other highvoltage components have "High Voltage" caution
labels. Do not carelessly touch these wires and
components.
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
D100875
IN–11
(c) Before inspecting or servicing the high-voltage
system, be sure to follow safety measures, such as
wearing insulated gloves and removing the service
plug to prevent electrocution. Carry the removed
service plug in your pocket to prevent other
technicians from reinstalling it while you are
servicing the vehicle.
(d) After removing the service plug, wait 5 minutes
before touching any of the high-voltage connectors
and terminals.
HINT:
5 minutes are required to discharge the high-voltage
condenser inside the inverter.
(e) Be sure to install the service plug before starting the
hybrid system. Starting the hybrid system with the
service plug removed may damage the vehicle.
(f)
DO NOT WEAR!
D100876E01
Before wearing insulated gloves, make sure that
they are not cracked, ruptured, torn, or damaged in
any way. Do not wear wet insulated gloves.
(g) When servicing the vehicle, do not carry metal
objects like mechanical pencils or scales that can be
dropped accidentally and cause a short circuit.
(h) Before touching a bare high-voltage terminal, wear
insulated gloves and use an electrical tester to
ensure that the terminal is not charged with
electricity (approximately 0 V).
(i)
D100877
After disconnecting or exposing a high-voltage
connector or terminal, insulate it immediately using
insulation tape.
(j) The screw of a high-voltage terminal should be
tightened firmly to the specified torque. Both
insufficient and excessive torque can cause failure.
(k) Use the "CAUTION: HIGH VOLTAGE. DO NOT
TOUCH DURING OPERATION." sign to notify other
engineers that a high-voltage system is being
inspected and/or repaired.
(l) Do not place the battery upside down while
removing and installing it.
IN
IN–12
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
(m) After servicing the high-voltage system and before
reinstalling the service plug, check again that you
have not left a part or tool inside, that the highvoltage terminal screws are firmly tightened, and
that the connectors are correctly connected.
IN
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
IN–13
IN
Person in charge:
CAUTION:
HIGH VOLTAGE. DO NOT
TOUCH DURING OPERATION.
CAUTION:
HIGH VOLTAGE. DO NOT
TOUCH DURING OPERATION.
Person in charge:
D100878
IN–14
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
3.
IN
4.
D100879
(3) Using a booster cable, connect the rescue
vehicle's 12 V battery positive (+) lead to the
stalled vehicle's relay block positive (+) terminal
and the negative (-) lead to the suspension
support's nut on the right side.
(4) Start the engine of the rescue vehicle and run
the engine at a speed slightly higher than the
idling speed for 5 minutes to charge the auxiliary
battery of the stalled vehicle.
1
4
3
PRECAUTIONS TO BE OBSERVED WHEN
INSPECTING OR SERVICING ENGINE
COMPARTMENT
The PRIUS automatically turns the engine ON and OFF
when the READY light on the instrument panel is ON. To
avoid injury, remove the key from the key slot before
inspecting or servicing the engine compartment.
ACTIONS TO BE TAKEN WHEN BATTERIES ARE
DEPLETED
(a) Perform this procedure when the auxiliary battery is
fully depleted.
HINT:
The following problems indicate that the auxiliary
battery is depleted:
• No display appears on the instrument panel
when the power switch's power mode is set to
ON (IG).
• The hybrid system does not start.
• The headlights are dim.
• The sound from the horn is weak.
NOTICE:
Never use a quick charger.
(1) Push the "P" position switch, and engage the
parking brake.
(2) Remove the key from the key slot.
2
D100880E01
D100881
(5) Depress the brake pedal and push the power
switch to start the hybrid system.
If the hybrid system fails to start and the master
light turns ON, the HV battery may be depleted.
(6) Disconnect the booster cable in the reverse
order of the connection procedure.
NOTICE:
If the auxiliary battery needs to be replaced,
replace it only with a 12 V battery specially
designed for use with the PRIUS.
(b) Perform this procedure when the HV battery is
depleted.
NOTICE:
Leaving the vehicle untouched for 2 to 3 months
may deplete the HV battery. If the battery is fully
depleted, replace the HV battery.
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
5.
IN–15
ACTIONS TO BE TAKEN FOR VEHICLE DAMAGED
BY IMPACT
(a) Items to be prepared for operation at the site of the
accident
• Protective clothing (insulated gloves, rubber
gloves, goggles, and safety shoes)
• Saturated boric acid solution 20 L (obtain 800 g
of boric acid powder, put it into a container, and
dissolve it in water)
• Red litmus paper
• ABC fire extinguisher (effective against both oil
flames and electrical flames)
• Shop rags (for wiping off the electrolyte)
• Vinyl tape (for insulating cable)
• Electrical tester
(b) Actions to be taken at the accident site
(1) Wear insulated or rubber gloves, goggles and
safety shoes.
(2) Do not touch a bare cable that could be a high
voltage cable. If the cable must be touched or if
accidental contact is unavoidable, follow these
instructions: 1) wear insulated or rubber gloves
and goggles, 2) measure the voltage between
the cable and the body ground using an
electrical tester, and 3) insulate the cable using
vinyl tape.
(3) If the vehicle catches on fire, use an ABC fire
extinguisher to extinguish the fire. Trying to
extinguish a fire using only a small amount of
water can be more dangerous than effective.
Use a substantial amount of water or wait for
firefighters.
(4) Visually check the HV battery and immediate
area for any electrolyte leakage. Do not touch
any leaked liquid because it could be a highly
alkaline electrolyte. Wear rubber gloves and
goggles, and then apply red litmus paper to the
leak. If the paper turns blue, the liquid must be
neutralized before wiping. Neutralize the liquid
using the following procedures: 1) apply
saturated boric acid solution to the liquid, and 2)
reapply red litmus paper and make sure it does
not turn blue. Repeat steps 1 and 2 above until
the paper does not turn blue. Then, wipe the
neutralized liquid with a shop rag.
IN
IN–16
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
(5) If damage to any of the high-voltage
components and cables is suspected, cut the
high-voltage circuit using the procedure below.
High-voltage Part and Wiring
HV Battery
IN
Inverter and Converter
Power Cable
A/C Compressor
Hybrid Transaxle
D100882E01
1. Push the "P" position switch and engage the
parking brake.
2. Remove the key from the key slot. Then
disconnect the negative (-) terminal of the
auxiliary battery.
3. Remove the service plug while wearing
insulated gloves.
CAUTION:
Do not turn the power switch on while
removing the service plug.
Service Plug
D100883E01
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
Engine Room Junction Block
Power Integration
IN–17
NOTICE:
If the service plug cannot be removed due to
damage to the rear portion of the vehicle,
remove the HV fuse or power integration
(IGCT relay) instead.
(c) Moving the damaged vehicle
HINT:
If any of the following applies, tow the vehicle away
using a tow truck.
• One or more of the high-voltage components and
cables are damaged.
• The driving, traction, or fuel system is damaged.
HV Fuse
D100884E01
READY
D100885
• The READY light is not illuminated when you
start the engine.
NOTICE:
• Before towing the vehicle away using a tow
truck, disconnect the cable from the negative
(-) terminal of the auxiliary battery and
remove the service plug. Only if none of the
above applies and there are no problems that
might affect driving, drive the vehicle away
from the accident site to a safe place nearby.
• Perform the procedure below if the READY
light turns off, or there are abnormal noises,
unusual smells, or strong vibrations while
driving:
(a)Park the vehicle in a safe place.
(b)Push the "P" position switch and engage
the parking brake.
(c)Disconnect the power cable from the
negative (-) terminal of the auxiliary
battery.
(d)Remove the service plug while wearing
insulated gloves.
IN
IN–18
IN
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
(d) Actions required after moving the damaged vehicle
If you see any liquid on the road surface, it could be
a highly alkaline electrolyte leakage.
Wear rubber gloves and goggles, and apply red
litmus paper to the leak. If the paper turns blue, the
liquid must be neutralized before wiping. Neutralize
the liquid using the following procedures: 1) apply
saturated boric acid solution to the liquid, and 2)
reapply red litmus paper and make sure it does not
turn blue. Repeat steps 1 and 2 above until the
paper does not turn blue. Then wipe the neutralized
liquid with a shop rag.
(e) Items to be prepared (when repairing damaged
vehicles)
• Protective clothing (insulated gloves, rubber
gloves, goggles, and safety shoes)
• Saturated boric acid solution 20 L (obtain 800 g
of boric acid powder, put it into a container, and
dissolve it in water)
• Red litmus paper
• Shop rags (for wiping off the electrolyte)
• Vinyl tape (for insulating cable)
• Electrical tester
(f) Precautions to be observed when servicing the
damaged vehicle
(1) Wear insulated or rubber gloves, goggles, and
safety shoes.
(2) Do not touch a bare cable that could be a high
voltage cable. If the cable must be touched or if
accidental contact is unavailable, follow these
instructions: 1) wear insulated or rubber gloves
and goggles, 2) measure the voltage between
the cable and the body ground using an
electrical tester, and 3) insulate the cable using
vinyl tape.
(3) Check the HV battery and immediate area for
any electrolyte leakage. Do not touch any leaked
liquid because it could be a highly alkaline
electrolyte. Wear rubber gloves and goggles,
and then apply red litmus paper to the leak. If the
paper turns blue, the liquid must be neutralized
before wiping. Neutralize the liquid using the
following procedures:
1) apply saturated boric acid solution to the
liquid, and 2) reapply red litmus paper and make
sure it does not turn blue. Repeat steps 1 and 2
above until the paper does not turn blue. Then
wipe the neutralized liquid with a shop rag.
(4) If the electrolyte adheres to your skin, wash the
skin immediately using saturated boric acid
solution or a large amount of water. If the
electrolyte adheres to an article of clothing, take
the clothing off immediately.
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
IN–19
(5) If the electrolyte comes in contact with your
eyes, call out loudly for help. Do not rub your
eyes. Wash them with a large amount of water
and seek medical care immediately.
(6) If damage to any of the high-voltage
components and cables is suspected, cut the
high-voltage circuit using the procedure below.
1. Push the "P" position switch and engage the
parking brake.
2. Remove the key from the key slot. Then
disconnect the power cable from the negative
(-) terminal of the auxiliary battery.
3. Wear insulated gloves, and then remove the
service plug.
NOTICE:
If you cannot remove the service plug due to
damage to the rear portion of the vehicle,
remove the HV fuse or IGCT relay instead.
(g) Precautions to be taken when disposing of the
vehicle
When scrapping the vehicle, remove the HV battery
from the vehicle and return it to the location
specified by the manufacturer. The same applies to
any damaged HV battery.
(h) After removing the battery, keep it away from water.
Water may heat the battery, which results in fire.
(i) Precautions to be observed when towing
Tow the damaged vehicle with its front wheels or its
front and rear wheels lifted off the ground.
NOTICE:
Towing the damaged vehicle with its front
wheels on the ground may cause the motor to
generate electricity. This electricity could,
depending on the nature of the damage, leak
and cause a fire.
(j) Towing with 4 wheels on the ground
NOTICE:
• If the damaged vehicle needs to be towed
using a rope, do not exceed 30 km/h and tow
only for very short distances. For example,
towing from the accident site to a nearby tow
truck is permissible.
• Change the power switch's power mode to
ON (IG) and shift the selector lever to the N
position.
• If any abnormality is present in the damaged
vehicle during towing, stop towing
immediately.
IN
IN–20
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
6.
IN
D100903
(k) Towing eyelet
(1) Install the hook.
(2) Hook a rope on to the illustrated area for towing.
FOR VEHICLES WITH SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT
SYSTEM
The PRIUS is equipped with a Supplemental Restraint
System (SRS). The SRS of this vehicle consists of the
following:
1. Steering pad
2. Front passenger airbag assembly
3. Curtain shield airbag assembly
4. Front seat side airbag assembly
5. Front seat outer belt assembly with pretensioner
6. Front airbag sensor assembly
7. Side airbag sensor assembly
8. Rear airbag sensor assembly
CAUTION:
• Failure to carry out service procedures in the
correct sequence could cause SRS parts to
unexpectedly deploy and possibly lead to serious
injuries. Furthermore, if a mistake is made when
servicing SRS parts, they may fail to operate when
required. Before performing servicing (including
installation/removal, inspection and replacement
of parts), be sure to read the following
precautions.
• Before starting work, wait at least 90 seconds
after the power switch is turned OFF and after the
cable of the negative (-) battery terminal is
disconnected. (SRS parts are equipped with a
backup power source. If work is started within 90
seconds of turning the power switch OFF and
disconnecting the cable from the negative (-)
battery terminal, SRS parts may deploy.)
• Do not expose SRS parts directly to hot air or
flames.
NOTICE:
• Malfunction symptoms of SRS parts are difficult
to confirm. DTCs are the most important source of
information when troubleshooting. During
troubleshooting, always confirm DTCs before
disconnecting the cable from the negative (-)
battery terminal.
• For minor collisions where SRS parts do not
deploy, always inspect the SRS parts.
• Before performing repairs, remove airbag sensors
as necessary if any kind of impact is likely to
occur to an airbag sensor during repairs.
• Never use SRS parts from another vehicle. When
replacing SRS parts, replace them with new ones.
• Never disassemble or attempt to repair SRS parts.
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
IN–21
• If an SRS part has been dropped, or if there are
any cracks, dents or other defects in the case,
bracket or connector, replace the SRS part with a
new one.
• Use an ohmmeter/voltmeter with high impedance
(10 kΩ/V minimum) for troubleshooting the
electrical circuits.
• Information labels are attached to the periphery of
SRS parts. Follow the cautions and instructions
on the labels.
• After work on SRS parts is completed, perform the
SRS warning light check.
• When the cable is disconnected from the negative
(-) battery terminal, the memory settings of each
system will be cleared. Because of this, be sure to
write down the settings of each system before
starting work. When work is finished, reset the
settings of each system as before. Never use a
backup power supply from outside the vehicle to
avoid erasing the memory in a system.
(a) SPIRAL CABLE
(1) The steering wheel must be fitted correctly to the
steering column with the spiral cable at the
neutral position, as cable disconnection and
other problems may occur. Refer to the
information about correct installation of the
steering wheel.
(b) AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(1) Airbag assembly with pad:
Always place a removed or new airbag
assembly with the pad surface facing upward.
Placing the airbag assembly with the airbag
inflation direction facing downward could cause
a serious accident if the airbag inflates. Also, do
not place anything on top of the airbag
assembly.
(2) Never measure the resistance of the airbag
squib. This may cause the airbag to inflate,
which could cause a serious injury.
(3) Grease or detergents of any kind should not be
applied to the airbag assembly.
(4) Store the airbag assembly in an area where the
ambient temperature is below 93°C (200°F), the
humidity is not high and there is no electrical
noise.
(5) When using electric welding anywhere on the
vehicle, disconnect the airbag ECU connectors.
These connectors contain shorting springs. This
feature reduces the possibility of the airbag
deploying due to currents entering the squib
wiring.
IN
IN–22
IN
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
(6) When disposing of the vehicle or the airbag
assembly by itself, the airbag should be
deployed using SST before disposal. Activate
the airbag in a safe place away from electrical
noise.
(c) SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY WITH
PRETENSIONER
(1) Never measure the resistance of the seat outer
belt. This may cause the pretensioner of the seat
outer belt to activate, which could cause a
serious injury.
(2) Never install the seat outer belt on another
vehicle.
(3) Store the seat outer belt in an area where the
ambient temperature is below 80°C (176°F), the
humidity is not high and there is no electrical
noise.
(4) When using electric welding anywhere on the
vehicle, disconnect the airbag ECU connectors.
These connectors contain shorting springs. This
feature reduces the possibility of the
pretensioner deploying due to currents entering
the squib wiring.
(5) When disposing of a vehicle or the seat outer
belt by itself, the pretensioner should be
activated before disposal. Activate the
pretensioner in a safe place away from electrical
noise.
(6) As the seat outer belt is hot after the
pretensioner is activated, allow some time for it
to cool down sufficiently before disposal. Never
apply water to try to cool down the seat outer
belt.
(7) Grease, detergents, oil or water should not be
applied to the seat outer belt.
(d) AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
(1) Never reuse an airbag sensor assembly that has
been involved in a collision where the SRS has
deployed.
(2) The connectors to the airbag sensor assembly
should be connected or disconnected with the
sensor placed on the floor. If the connectors are
connected or disconnected while the airbag
sensor assembly is not placed on the floor, the
SRS may activate.
(3) Work must be started at least 90 seconds after
the power switch is turned OFF and the cable is
disconnected from the negative (-) battery
terminal, even if only loosening the set bolts of
the airbag sensor assembly.
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
IN–23
(e) WIRE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
(1) The SRS wire harness is integrated with the
instrument panel wire harness assembly. All the
connectors in the system are yellow. If the SRS
wire harness becomes disconnected or the
connector becomes broken, repair or replace it.
7.
Negative (-) Cable
Negative (-)
Battery
Terminal
D100727E01
INCORRECT
D100728E01
8.
ELECTRONIC CONTROL
(a) REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION OF BATTERY
TERMINAL
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
(1) Before performing electronic work, disconnect
the cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent component and wire damage caused by
accidental short circuits.
(2) When disconnecting the cable, turn the power
switch OFF and headlight dimmer switch OFF
and loosen the cable nut completely. Perform
these operations without twisting or prying the
cable. Then disconnect the cable.
(3) Clock settings, radio settings, audio system
memory, DTCs and other data are erased when
the cable is disconnected from the negative (-)
battery terminal. Write down any necessary data
before disconnecting the cable.
(b) HANDLING OF ELECTRONIC PARTS
(1) Do not open the cover or case of the ECU
unless absolutely necessary. If the IC terminals
are touched, the IC may be rendered inoperative
by static electricity.
(2) Do not pull the wires when disconnecting
electronic connectors. Pull the connector.
(3) Be careful not to drop electronic components,
such as sensors or relays. If they are dropped
on a hard surface, they should be replaced.
(4) When cleaning the engine with steam, protect
the electronic components, air filter and
emission-related components from water.
(5) Never use an impact wrench to remove or install
temperature switches or temperature sensors.
(6) When measuring the resistance of a wire
connector, insert the tester probe carefully to
prevent terminals from bending.
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION OF FUEL CONTROL
PARTS
(a) PLACE FOR REMOVING AND INSTALLING FUEL
SYSTEM PARTS
(1) Work in a location with good air ventilation that
does not have welders, grinders, drills, electric
motors, stoves, or any other ignition sources.
(2) Never work in a pit or near a pit as vaporized
fuel will collect in those places.
IN
IN–24
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
(b) REMOVING AND INSTALLING FUEL SYSTEM
PARTS
(1) Prepare a fire extinguisher before starting the
operation.
(2) To prevent static electricity, install a ground wire
to the fuel changer, vehicle and fuel tank, and do
not spray the surrounding area with water. Be
careful when performing work in this area, as the
work surface will become slippery. Do not clean
up gasoline spills with water, as this may cause
the gasoline to spread, and possibly create a fire
hazard.
(3) Avoid using electric motors, working lights and
other electric equipment that can cause sparks
or high temperatures.
(4) Avoid using iron hammers as they may create
sparks.
(5) Dispose of fuel-contaminated cloth separately
using a fire resistant container.
IN
9.
D100729
Spring Type Clamp
Clamp Track
D100730E01
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION OF ENGINE INTAKE
PARTS
(a) If any metal particles enter inlet system parts, they
may damage the engine.
(b) When removing and installing inlet system parts,
cover the openings of the removed parts and engine
openings. Use gummed tape or other suitable
materials.
(c) When installing inlet system parts, check that no
metal particles have entered the engine or the
installed parts.
10. HANDLING OF HOSE CLAMPS
(a) Before removing the hose, check the clamp position
so that it can be reinstalled in the same position.
(b) Replace any deformed or dented clamps with new
ones.
(c) When reusing a hose, attach the clamp on the
clamp track portion of the hose.
(d) For a spring type clamp, you may want to spread
the tabs slightly after installation by pushing in the
direction of the arrows as shown in the illustration.
11. FOR VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH MOBILE
COMMUNICATION SYSTEMS
(a) Install the antenna as far away from the ECU and
sensors of the vehicle electronic systems as
possible.
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
D100731
DLC3
CG
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
TS
B105749E01
IN–25
(b) Install an antenna feeder at least 20 cm (7.87 in.)
away from the ECU and sensors of the vehicle
electronic systems. For details about ECU and
sensor locations, refer to the section of the
applicable components.
(c) Keep the antenna and feeder separate from other
wiring as much as possible. This will prevent signals
from the communication equipment from affecting
vehicle equipment and vice versa.
(d) Check that the antenna and feeder are correctly
adjusted.
(e) Do not install a high-powered mobile
communication system.
12. FOR VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH VEHICLE
STABILITY (VSC) SYSTEM
(a) NOTICES WHEN USING DRUM TESTER
(1) Before beginning testing, disable the VSC. To
disable the VSC, turn the power switch OFF and
connect SST to terminals 12 (TS) and 4 (CG) of
the DLC3.
SST 09843-18040
NOTICE:
• Confirm that the VSC warning light blinks.
• The VSC system will be reset when the
engine is started.
• For safety, secure the vehicle with
restraint chains while using a wheel
dynamometer.
(b) NOTICES OF RELATED OPERATIONS TO VSC
(1) Do not carry out unnecessary installation and
removal as it might affect the adjustment of VSC
related parts.
(2) Be sure to follow the instructions for work
preparation and final confirmation of proper
operation of the VSC system.
13. FOR VEHICLES EQUIPPED WITH CATALYTIC
CONVERTER
CAUTION:
If a large amount of unburned gasoline or gasoline
vapors flow into the converter, it may cause
overheating and create a fire hazard. To prevent this,
observe the following precautions.
(a) Use only unleaded gasoline.
(b) Avoid idling the engine for more than 20 minutes.
(c) Avoid performing unnecessary spark jump tests.
(1) Perform a spark jump test only when absolutely
necessary. Perform this test as rapidly as
possible.
(2) While testing, never race the engine.
(d) Avoid a prolonged engine compression
measurement. Engine compression measurements
must be performed as rapidly as possible.
IN
IN–26
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
(e) Do not run the engine when the fuel tank is nearly
empty. This may cause the engine to misfire and
create an extra load on the converter.
IN
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
IN–27
VEHICLE LIFT AND SUPPORT
LOCATIONS
1.
2.
3.
Rubber Attachment
D100906E01
NOTICE ABOUT VEHICLE CONDITION WHEN
JACKING UP VEHICLE
(a) The vehicle must be unloaded before jacking up /
lifting up the vehicle. Never jack up / lift up a heavily
loaded vehicle.
(b) When removing heavy parts such as the engine and
transmission, the center of gravity of the vehicle
may shift. To stabilize the vehicle, place a balance
weight in a location where it will not roll or shift, or
use a mission jack to hold the jacking support.
NOTICE FOR USING 4 POST LIFT
(a) Follow the safety procedures outlined in the lift
instruction manual.
(b) Use precautionary measures to prevent the free
wheel beam from damaging tires or wheels.
(c) Use wheel chocks to secure the vehicle.
NOTICE FOR USING JACK AND SAFETY STAND
(a) Work on a level surface. Use wheel chocks at all
times.
(b) Use safety stands with rubber attachments as
shown in the illustration.
(c) Set the jack and safety stands to the specified
locations of the vehicle accurately.
(d) When jacking up the vehicle, first release the
parking brake and move the shift lever to N.
(e) When jacking up the entire vehicle:
• When jacking up the front wheels first, make sure
wheel chocks are behind the rear wheels.
• When jacking up the rear wheels first, make sure
wheel chocks are in front of the front wheels.
(f) When jacking up only the front or rear wheels of the
vehicle:
• Before jacking up the front wheels, place wheel
chocks on both sides of the rear wheels.
• Before jacking up the rear wheels, place wheel
chocks on both sides of the front wheels.
(g) When lowering a vehicle that only has its front or
rear wheels jacked up:
• Before lowering the front wheels, make sure
wheel chocks are in front of the rear wheels.
• Before lowering the rear wheels, make sure
wheel chocks are behind the front wheels.
IN
IN–28
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
IN
D100907
JACK POSITION
Front: Engine under cover
Rear: Differential carrier
CAUTION:
When jacking-up the vehicle, make sure the vehicle is
not carrying any extra weight.
SUPPORT POSITION
Safety stand and swing arm type lift
-
4.
(h) It is extremely dangerous to perform any work on a
vehicle raised on a jack alone, even for work that
can be finished quickly. Safety stands must be used
to support it.
NOTICE FOR USING SWING ARM TYPE LIFT
(a) Follow the safety procedures outlined in its
instruction manual.
(b) Use a swing arm equipped with a rubber
attachment, as shown in the illustration.
(c) When using the lift, make sure that the vehicle is
stabilized so that it will not tilt while work is being
performed. Stabilize the vehicle by adjusting the lift
arm's length and vehicle's position.
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
IN–29
(d) When using the lift, its center should be as close to
the vehicle's center of gravity as possible (length of
"L" in the illustration should be as short as possible).
IN
L
D100908E02
5.
(e) Set the vehicle on the lift as level as possible. Then
match the groove of the cradle to the rigid rack
support location.
(f) Be sure to lock the swing arms before lifting and
during work (if equipped with arm locks).
(g) Lift the vehicle up off the ground. Stand at a safe
distance and shake the vehicle to check its stability.
NOTICE FOR USING PLATE TYPE LIFT
(a) Follow safety procedures outlined in its instruction
manual.
(b) Use plate lift attachments (rubber lifting blocks) on
top of the plate surface.
IN–30
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
(c) Refer to the illustration below to determine how to
properly set the vehicle.
IN
B
Attachment
C
A
85 mm (3.35 in.)
Attachment Dimensions
70 mm (2.76 in.)
100 mm (3.94 in.)
200 mm (7.87 in.)
D100909E01
HINT:
Right and left set position
Place the vehicle over the center of the lift.
Front and rear set position
Place the attachments at the ends of the rubber plate surface, under
the vehicle lift pad (A and C in the illustration). Raise the plate slightly
and reposition the vehicle so the top of the attachment (B in the
illustration) is aligned with the front side notch in the vehicle rocker
flange.
(d) Use the lift to raise the vehicle up off the ground,
and shake the vehicle to make sure that it is stable.
IN–31
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
CUSTOMIZE PARAMETERS
HINT:
The following items can be customized.
NOTICE:
• When the customer requests a change in a function,
first make sure that the function can be customized.
• Be sure to make a note of the current settings before
customizing.
• When troubleshooting a function, first make sure that
the function is set to the default setting.
1. Air conditioning amplifier
Display (Item)
Default
Contents
Setting
SET TEMP SHIFT (Set
Temperature Shift)
NORMAL
To control with the shifted
temperature against the display
temperature.
+2C / +1C / NORMAL / -1C / -2C
AIR INLET MODE (Air Inlet
Mode)
AUTO
In case of turning the A/C ON
when you desire to make the
compartment cool down quickly,
this is the function to change the
mode automatically to
RECIRCULATED mode.
MANUAL / AUTO
COMPRESSOR MODE
(Compressor Mode)
AUTO
Function to turn the A/C ON
automatically by pressing the
AUTO button when the blower is
ON and the A/C is OFF.
MANUAL / AUTO
COMPRS/DEF OPER
(Compressor/Air inlet DEF
operation)
LINK
Function to turn the A/C ON
automatically linking with the
FRONT DEF button when the A/C
is OFF.
NORMAL / LINK
FOOT/DEF MODE (Foot/DEF
auto mode)
ON
Function to turn the air flow from
FOOT/DEF to ON automatically
when AUTO MODE is ON.
OFF / ON
AUTO BLOW UP (Foot/DEF
automatic blow up function)
ON
Function to switch the blower
level automatically when the
defroster is ON.
OFF / ON
FOOT AIR LEAK (Foot air leak)
ON
Function to cut off the airstream
felt underfoot while the vehicle is
moving.
OFF / ON
AMBINT TMP SFT (Ambient
Temperature Shift)
NORMAL
To control with the shifted
ambient temperature against the
display ambient temperature.
+3C / +2C / +1C / NORMAL / -1C
/ -2C / -3C
2.
Illuminated entry
Display (Item)
Default
Contents
Setting
LIGHTING TIME
15 s
Changes lighting time after
closing doors (light quickly fades
out when power switch is turned
ON (IG)
7.5 s / 15 s / 30 s
I/L AUTO OFF
ON
Illumination AUTO OFF ON
function to turn off interior light
automatically after specified time
for prevent the battery loss when
the interior light switch is "DOOR"
position and the door is open
ON / OFF
I/L ON/UNLOCK
ON
Function to light interior light, etc.
when the door is unlocked with a
transmitter, door key or door lock
control switch
ON / OFF
IN
IN–32
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
Display (Item)
Default
Contents
Setting
I/L ON/ACC OFF
ON
Illuminates interior light when
power switch is turned from the
ON (ACC) to ON (IG) position
ON / OFF
3.
IN
Smart key system
Display (Item)
Default
Contents
Setting
SMART WARN 1
(Warns if key is taken from Ddoor with P position)
ON
Function that warns driver that
key is taken out from driver's door
when shift position is P and power
switch is not OFF
ON / OFF
SMART WARN 2
(Warns if key is taken from Ddoor without P position)
ON
Function that warns driver that
key is taken out from driver's door
when shift position is not P and
power switch is not OFF
ON / OFF
SMART WARN 3
(Warns if key is taken out by other
passengers)
ON
Function that warns driver that
key is taken out from front
passenger's door by passenger
when power switch is not OFF
ON / OFF
SMART BUZ NUM
(Sets number of warning buzzer
sounds)
3 TIMES
Function that sets number of
warning buzzer sounds when key
is taken out of vehicle
OFF / 3TIMES / 5TIMES /
7TIMES
SMART WARN 4
(Warning time for locking door
when engine is idling)
2s
Function that sets warning time
for locking doors while engine is
idling
OFF / 1s / 2s
SMART WARN 5
(Warning when key is left in
vehicle)
2s
Function that sets warning time
for locking doors while key is
inside vehicle
OFF / 1s/ 2s
SMART WARN 6
(Warning if starting engine when
key is out of detection range)
ON
Function that warns driver that
entry ignition control is being
attempted to be activated while
key is out of detection range
ON / OFF
KEY LOW-BATT WRN
(Warning when key battery
becomes weak)
ON
Function that warns driver that
key's battery power is low
ON / OFF
SMART UNLOCK
(Entry door unlock mode)
EACH
Function that makes entry unlock
operation available.
ALL / EACH / D-door
TRANSMIT INTVAL
(Transmission interval)
0.3s
Function that sets entry signal
transmission intervals when
vehicle is stopped and key is
outside vehicle
0.15s / 0.3s / 0.45s / 0.6s
PARK WAIT TIME
(Waiting time to permit door
opening of door after locking)
3.0s
Function that sets waiting time to
permit opening door after door is
locked with entry lock function
0.5s / 1.5s / 2.5s / 5s
SMART BACK DOOR
(Back door opening operation
when vehicle is locked)
LONG
Function that enables back door
to open when key is inside
luggage room
LONG / TWICE / OFF
4.
Display (Items)
OPEN DOOR WARN (Door ajar
warning function
WIRLS BUZZ OPER (Buzzer
answer-back for wireless door
lock operation)
ALARM FUNCTION (Panic
function)
Default
Wireless door lock control system
Contents
Setting
ON
If door is not completely closed
and transmitter LOCK switch is
pressed, this function sounds
buzzer for 10 seconds
ON / OFF
ON
Function that makes wireless
buzzer sound for answer-back
when transmitter LOCK/UNLOCK
switch is pressed
ON / OFF
ON
Function that operates theft
deterrent alarm when transmitter
PANIC switch transmitter is held
0.8 seconds.
ON / OFF
IN–33
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
Display (Items)
UNLOCK/2OPER (Wireless
unlock operated twice)
AUTO LOCK DELAY (Auto lock
time)
HAZARD ANS BACK (Hazard
answer-back for wireless door
lock operation)
Default
Contents
Setting
ON
Function that unlocks driver side
door when UNLOCK switch on
transmitter is pressed once, and
unlocks all doors when pressed
twice. If set to OFF, pressing
UNLOCK switch once unlocks all
doors.
ON / OFF
30s
This function controls amount of
time from unlocking doors to
automatic re-locking function
30s / 60s
ON
When LOCK switch on
transmitter is pressed, this
function illuminates all hazard
warning lights once. When
UNLOCK switch is pressed, all
hazard warning lights illuminate
twice
ON / OFF
5.
Display (Item)
Default
IN
Theft deterrent system
Contents
Setting
OFF
PASSIVE MODE is a function that
switches theft deterrent system
from arming preparation state to
armed state 30 seconds after key
is removed from key slot and all
doors is closed, even if doors are
not locked by wireless or door key
lock operation.
In PASSIVE MODE, theft
deterrent system will judge that a
theft is taking place and switch to
alarm sounding state if one of the
following operations are not
performed within 14 seconds (see
ENTRY DELAY below) after door
is opened:
• Unlock any door by key or
wireless operation
• Reconnect battery
• Insert key into key slot and
turn power switch ON (IG)
ON / OFF
WARN BY HORN (Warning by
horn)
ON
Function that allows vehicle horn
and theft deterrent horn to be
able to be used and a warning
device
ON / OFF
ENTRY DELAY (Entry delay time)
14 s
Function that changes entry delay
time (time before warning states)
0 s/14 s/ 30 s
WARN BY GLS SEN (Warning by
glass broken sensor)
ON
Function that turns glass broken
sensor ON/OFF
ON / OFF
PASSIVE MODE (Passive arming
mode)
IN–34
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
INITIALIZATION
System Name
Power Window Control System
1.
IN
RESET (INITIALIZE) POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
MOTOR (DRIVER SIDE)
NOTICE:
• Resetting the power window regulator motor
(initializing the pulse sensor) is necessary if one
of the following occurs: 1) the battery cable is
disconnected; 2) the power window regulator
master switch, wire harness, power window
regulator switch, power window regulator or
power window regulator motor is replaced or
removed / installed; or 3) the Power fuse, FR Door
fuse, GAUGE fuse and ECU-IG fuse are replaced.
If resetting is not performed, the master switch
will not be able to operate the AUTO UP / DOWN
function, jam protection function and remote
operation function.
• Whenever disconnecting the cable from the
negative (-) battery terminal, reset all the other
systems besides the power window control
system.
(a) Change the power mode to ON (IG) by pushing the
power switch.
(b) Open the power window halfway by pressing the
power window switch.
(c) Fully pull up on the switch until the power window is
fully closed and continue to hold the switch for at
least 1 second.
(d) Check that the AUTO UP / DOWN function operates
normally.
If the AUTO UP / DOWN function operates normally,
reset operations are complete. If abnormal, follow
the 3 steps below.
(e) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal for 10 seconds.
(f) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery
terminal.
(g) Perform the first 4 steps again.
If the AUTO UP / DOWN function operates normally,
reset operations have been completed at this time.
If abnormal, follow the 4 steps below.
(h) Change the power mode to ON (IG) by pushing the
power switch.
(i) Open the power window halfway by pressing the
power window switch.
(j) Fully pull up on the switch until the power window is
fully closed and continue to hold the switch for
approximately 12 seconds after the power window
is fully closed.
(k) Check that the AUTO UP / DOWN function
operates normally.
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
IN–35
INSPECTION MODE PROCEDURE
1.
INSPECTION MODE
HINT:
• The PRIUS' engine automatically stops if the vehicle
is stopped, the engine is warmed up, the battery is
well charged, and A/C compressor operation is not
being used. Activate inspection mode when
continuous operation of the engine is required.
• The PRIUS has a motor TRAC function. When the
wheel speed of the front wheels exceeds that of the
rear wheels, the wheel speed of the front wheels is
restrained. It is necessary to activate inspection mode
and deactivate the motor TRAC function when turning
only the front wheels using a speedometer tester.
(a) Vehicle conditions
(1) Before activating inspection mode, turn the air
conditioning off, start the engine with the
selector lever in the P position, and check that
the engine stops within several seconds after
starting (engine warm up check).
(2) Activate inspection mode and inspect the
vehicle. The shift position for each test is as
follows:
Test item
Shift position
Inspection mode
Vehicle straight traveling test (side slip
inspection)
D
ON or OFF
Breaking force test
N
ON or OFF
Speedometer test
D
ON
Exhaust gas test (idling)
P
ON
Headlight test
P
ON or OFF
(3) Reset inspection mode immediately after
completion of the inspection.
NOTICE:
Driving the vehicle without resetting
inspection mode may damage the transaxle.
(b) Special notes for speedometer test
NOTICE:
Do not use the speedometer tester to perform
rapid starting or quick acceleration/deceleration
without first setting the proper load on the
vehicle. Failing to set the load may damage the
transaxle.
(1) Depress the accelerator pedal slowly and
gradually accelerate the vehicle. Make a
measurement.
(2) After the measurement, use the brake pedal to
gradually decelerate the vehicle.
(c) Special note for using the chassis dynamometer
Always set an appropriate load before starting the
test.
IN
IN–36
INTRODUCTION – REPAIR INSTRUCTION
(d) Activating inspection mode
(1) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(2) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(3) Turn the intelligent tester ON.
(4) Select from the tester menus: Powertrain, Hybrid
Control, Active Test, Inspection Mode - 2WD
Inspection.
Multi-information Display:
IN
HV System Warning
D100904E01
Combination Meter:
Master Warning Light
D100905E01
(5) Check that the HV system warning light flashes
on the multi-information display and the master
warning light is illuminated in the combination
meter.
(e) Deactivating inspection mode
(1) Turn the power switch OFF.
NOTICE:
• The idling speed in inspection mode is
approximately 1,000 rpm. The engine
speed increases to 1,500 rpm if the
accelerator pedal is depressed by less
than 60%. If the accelerator pedal is
depressed by more than 60%, the engine
speed increases to 2,500 rpm.
• If a DTC is set during inspection mode, the
master warning light and the error
warning light illuminate on the multiinformation display.
• When the master warning light illuminates
during inspection mode, deactivate
inspection mode, and check for DTC(s).
• Driving the vehicle without deactivating
inspection mode may damage the
transaxle.
IN–36
INTRODUCTION – HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED SYSTEMS
HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU
CONTROLLED SYSTEMS
GENERAL INFORMATION
IN
A large number of ECU controlled systems are used in the
PRIUS. In general, ECU controlled systems are considered to
be very intricate, requiring a high level of technical knowledge
to troubleshoot. However, most problem checking procedures
only involve inspecting the ECU controlled system's circuits
one by one. An adequate understanding of the system and a
basic knowledge of electricity is enough to perform effective
troubleshooting, accurate diagnoses and necessary repairs.
FOR USING INTELLIGENT TESTER
Connect the cable of the intelligent tester to the DLC3, turn
the power switch ON (IG) and attempt to use the tester. If
the display indicates that a communication error has
occurred, there is a problem either with the vehicle or with
the tester.
* If communication is normal when the tester is
connected to another vehicle, inspect the DLC3 of the
original vehicle.
* If communication is still not possible when the tester is
connected to another vehicle, the problem may be in
the tester itself. Consult the Service Department listed
in the tester's instruction manual.
Intelligent Tester
DLC3
CAN VIM
B126098E01
INTRODUCTION – HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED SYSTEMS
IN–37
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
1.
1
OPERATION FLOW
HINT:
Perform troubleshooting in accordance with the
procedures below. The following is an outline of basic
troubleshooting procedures. Confirm the troubleshooting
procedures for the circuit you are working on before
beginning troubleshooting.
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS
(a) Ask the customer about the conditions and environment
when the problem occurred.
NEXT
3
INSPECT BATTERY VOLTAGE
Standard voltage:
11 to 14 V
If the voltage is below 11 V, recharge or replace the battery
before proceeding.
NEXT
4
SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION AND DTC (AND FREEZE FRAME DATA) CHECK
(a) Visually check the wire harnesses, connectors and fuses
for open and short circuits.
(b) Warm up the engine to the normal operating
temperature.
(c) Confirm the problem symptoms and conditions, and
check for DTCs.
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC is output
A
DTC is not output
B
B
A
Go to step 6
IN
IN–38
5
INTRODUCTION – HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED SYSTEMS
DTC CHART
(a) Check the results obtained in the DTC check. Then find
the output DTC in the DTC chart. Look at the "Trouble
Area" column for a list of potentially malfunctioning
circuits and / or parts.
IN
NEXT
6
Go to step 7
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
(a) Check the results obtained in the symptom confirmation.
Then find the problem symptoms in the problem
symptoms table. Look at the "Suspected Area" column
for a list of potentially malfunctioning circuits and / or
parts.
NEXT
7
CIRCUIT INSPECTION OR PARTS INSPECTION
(a) Confirm the malfunctioning circuit or part.
NEXT
8
ADJUST, REPAIR OR REPLACE
(a) Adjust, repair or replace the malfunctioning circuit or
parts.
NEXT
9
CONFIRMATION TEST
(a) After the adjustment, repairs or replacement, confirm
that the malfunction no longer exists. If the malfunction
does not reoccur, perform a confirmation test under the
same conditions and in the same environment as when
the malfunction occurred the first time.
NEXT
END
2.
CUSTOMER PROBLEM ANALYSIS
IN–39
INTRODUCTION – HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED SYSTEMS
HINT:
• In troubleshooting, confirm that the problem symptoms
have been accurately identified. Preconceptions should be
discarded in order to make an accurate judgment. To
clearly understand what the problem symptoms are, it is
extremely important to ask the customer about the
problem and the conditions at the time the malfunction
occurred.
• Gather as much information as possible for reference.
Past problems that seem unrelated may also help in some
cases.
• The following 5 items are important points in the problem
analysis:
What
Vehicle model, system name
When
Date, time, occurrence frequency
Where
Road conditions
Under what conditions?
Running conditions, driving conditions, weather conditions
How did it happen?
Problem symptoms
3.
SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION AND DIAGNOSTIC
TROUBLE CODE
HINT:
The diagnostic system in the PRIUS has various
functions.
• The first function is the Diagnostic Trouble Code
(DTC) check. A DTC is a code stored in the ECU
memory whenever a malfunction in the signal circuits
to the ECU occurs. In a DTC check, a previous
malfunction's DTC can be checked by a technician
during troubleshooting.
• Another function is the Input Signal Check, which
checks if the signals from various switches are sent to
the ECU correctly.
By using these functions, the problem areas can be
narrowed down and troubleshooting is more effective.
Diagnostic functions are incorporated in the following
system in the PRIUS.
Data List
Active Test
{
{
{
{
{
{
{
{
{
{
Electronically
Controlled
Brake System
{
{
{
{
Smart Key
System (for
Starting)
{
{
{
Airbag System
{
Occupant
Classification
System
{
System
DTC Check
(Normal Mode)
DTC Check
(Check Mode)
Freeze Frame
Data
SFI System
{
{
Hybrid Control
System
{
{
Hybrid Battery
System
{
Sensor Check
/ Test Mode
(Input Signal
Check)
{
{
{
{
Customize
Parameter
IN
IN–40
IN
INTRODUCTION – HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED SYSTEMS
{
{
{
{
{
{
{
{
{
{
{
{
{
{
{
Electronic Shift
Lever System
{
{
{
Electronic
Power Steering
System
{
{
{
Tire Pressure
Warning
System
{
Lighting
System
{
{
Smart Key
System (for
Door Lock)
Sensor Check
/ Test Mode
(Input Signal
Check)
Customize
Parameter
Air
Conditioning
System
Power Door
Lock Control
System
Freeze Frame
Data
Active Test
DTC Check
(Normal Mode)
Meter / Gauge
System
DTC Check
(Check Mode)
Data List
System
{
{
Wireless Door
Lock Control
System (w/
Smart Key)
{
{
{
{
Wireless Door
Lock Control
System (w/o
Smart Key)
{
{
{
{
Key Reminder
Warning
System
{
Power Window
Control System
{
Cruise Control
System
{
{
{
Engine
Immobiliser
System (w/
Smart Key
System)
{
{
{
Engine
Immobiliser
System (w/o
Smart Key
System)
{
{
{
{
{
Theft Deterrent
System
Audio and
Visual System
{
Navigation
System
{
Rear View
Monitor System
{
Multiplex
Communication
System
{
{
INTRODUCTION – HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED SYSTEMS
System
DTC Check
(Normal Mode)
DTC Check
(Check Mode)
CAN
Communication
System
{
{
Freeze Frame
Data
Sensor Check
/ Test Mode
(Input Signal
Check)
Data List
Active Test
IN–41
Customize
Parameter
• In the DTC check, it is very important to determine
whether the problem indicated by the DTC is either: 1)
still occurring, or 2) occurred in the past but has since
returned to normal. In addition, the DTC should be
compared to the problem symptom to see if they are
related. For this reason, DTCs should be checked
before and after confirmation of symptoms (i.e.,
whether or not problem symptoms exist) to determine
current system conditions, as shown in the flowchart
below.
• Never skip the DTC check. Failing to check DTCs
may, depending on the case, result in unnecessary
troubleshooting for systems operating normally or
lead to repairs not related to the problem. Follow the
procedures listed in the flowchart in the correct order.
• The following flowchart shows how to proceed with
troubleshooting using the DTC check. Directions from
the flowchart will indicate how to proceed either to
DTC troubleshooting or to the troubleshooting of each
problem symptom.
1
DTC CHECK
NEXT
2
MAKE A NOTE OF DTCS DISPLAYED AND THEN CLEAR MEMORY
NEXT
3
SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION
Result
Result
Proceed to
No symptoms exist
A
Symptoms exist
B
B
A
Go to step 5
IN
IN–42
4
INTRODUCTION – HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED SYSTEMS
SIMULATION TEST USING SYMPTOM SIMULATION METHODS
NEXT
IN
5
DTC CHECK
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC is not output
A
DTC is output
B
B
TROUBLESHOOTING OF PROBLEM
INDICATED BY DTC
A
6
SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION
Result
Result
Proceed to
Symptoms exist
A
No symptoms exist
B
If a DTC was displayed in the initial DTC check, the problem
may have occurred in a wire harness or connector in that
circuit in the past. Check the wire harness and connectors.
B
SYSTEM NORMAL
A
TROUBLESHOOTING OF EACH PROBLEM SYMPTOM
The problem is still occurring in a place other than the
diagnostic circuit (the DTC displayed first is either for a past
problem or a secondary problem).
4. SYMPTOM SIMULATION
HINT:
The most difficult case in troubleshooting is when no
problem symptoms occur. In such a case, a thorough
problem analysis must be carried out. A simulation of the
same or similar conditions and environment in which the
problem occurred in the customer's vehicle should be
carried out. No matter how much skill or experience a
technician has, troubleshooting without confirming the
problem symptoms will lead to important repairs being
overlooked and mistakes or delays.
INTRODUCTION – HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED SYSTEMS
IN–43
For example:
With a problem that only occurs when the engine is
cold or as a result of vibration caused by the road
during driving, the problem can never be
determined if the symptoms are being checked on
a stationary vehicle or on a vehicle with a warmedup engine. Vibration, heat or water penetration
(moisture) is difficult to reproduce. The symptom
simulation tests below are effective substitutes for
the conditions and can be applied on a stationary
vehicle.
Important points in the symptom simulation test:
In the symptom simulation test, the problem
symptoms as well as the problem area or parts
must be confirmed. First, narrow down the
possible problem circuits according to the
symptoms. Then, connect the tester and carry out
the symptom simulation test, judging whether the
circuit being tested is defective or normal. Also,
confirm the problem symptoms at the same time.
Refer to the problem symptoms table for each
system to narrow down the possible causes.
Vibrate Slightly
Shake Slightly
Vibrate Slightly
D100732E01
(a) VIBRATION METHOD:
When a malfunction seems to occur as a result of
vibration.
(1) PART AND SENSOR
Apply slight vibration with a finger to the part of
the sensor suspected to be the cause of the
problem, and check whether or not the
malfunction occurs.
NOTICE:
Applying strong vibration to relays may open
them.
(2) CONNECTORS
Slightly shake the connector vertically and
horizontally.
(3) WIRE HARNESS
Slightly shake the wire harness vertically and
horizontally.
HINT:
The connector joint and fulcrum of the vibration
are the major areas that should be checked
thoroughly.
(b) HEAT METHOD:
When a malfunction seems to occur when the area
in question is heated.
(1) Heat the component that is the possible cause of
the malfunction with a hair dryer or similar
device. Check if the malfunction occurs.
NOTICE:
• Do not heat to more than 60°C (140°F).
Exceeding this temperature may damage
components.
IN
IN–44
INTRODUCTION – HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED SYSTEMS
• Do not apply heat directly to the parts in
the ECU.
(c) WATER SPRINKLING METHOD:
When a malfunction seems to occur on a rainy day
or in high-humidity.
(1) Sprinkle water onto the vehicle and check if the
malfunction occurs.
NOTICE:
• Never sprinkle water directly into the
engine compartment. Indirectly change
the temperature and humidity by spraying
water onto the front of the radiator.
• Never apply water directly onto the
electronic components.
HINT:
If the vehicle has or had a water leakage
problem, the leakage may have damaged the
ECU or connections. Look for evidence of
corrosion or short circuits. Proceed with caution
during water tests.
IN
D025085E02
AUTO
B107149
(d) HIGH ELECTRICAL LOAD METHOD:
When a malfunction seems to occur when the
electrical load is excessive.
(1) Turn on the heater blower, headlight, rear
window defogger and all other electrical loads.
Check if the malfunction reoccurs.
5. DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
Look for output Diagnostic Trouble Codes (DTCs) (from the
DTC checks) in the appropriate section's Diagnostic Trouble
Code Chart. Use the chart to determine the trouble area and
the proper inspection procedure. A description of each of the
chart's columns is below.
Item
Description
DTC No.
Indicates the diagnostic trouble code
Detection Item
Indicates the system or details of the problem
Trouble Area
Indicates the suspected areas of the problem
See Page
Indicates the page where the inspection procedures for each circuit
are to be found, or gives instruction for checking and repairs
6.
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
When a "Normal" code is output during a DTC check but
the problem is still occurring, use the Problem Symptoms
Table. The suspected areas (circuits or parts) for each
problem symptom are in the table. The suspected areas
are listed in order of probability. A description of each of
the chart's columns is below.
HINT:
In some cases, the problem is not detected by the
diagnostic system even though a problem symptom is
present. It is possible that the problem is occurring
outside the detection range of the diagnostic system, or
that the problem is occurring in a completely different
system.
INTRODUCTION – HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED SYSTEMS
IN–45
Item
Description
Symptom
-
Suspected Area
Indicates the circuit or part which needs to be checked
See Page
Indicates the page where the flowchart for each circuit is located
7.
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
A description of the main areas of each circuit inspection
is below.
Item
Description
Description
The major role, operation of the circuit and its component parts are
explained.
DTC No. DTC Detection Condition, Trouble Area
Indicates the diagnostic trouble codes, diagnostic trouble code
detection conditions, and trouble areas of a problem.
Wiring Diagram
This shows a wiring diagram of the circuit.
Use this diagram together with ELECTRICAL WIRING DIAGRAM to
thoroughly understand the circuit.
Wire colors are indicated by an alphabetical code:
• B = Black
• L = Blue
• R = Red
• BR = Brown
• LG = Light Green
• V = Violet
• G = Green
• O = Orange
• W = White
• GR = Gray
• P = Pink
• Y = Yellow
• SB = Sky Blue
The first letter indicates the basic wire color and the second letter
indicates the color of the stripe.
Inspection Procedures
Use the inspection procedures to determine if the circuit is normal or
abnormal. If abnormal, use the inspection procedures to determine
whether the problem is located in the sensors, actuators, wire
harnesses or ECU.
Indicates the condition of the connector of the ECU during the check
Connector being checked is connected.
Connections of tester are indicated by (+) or (-) after the terminal
name.
Connector being checked is disconnected.
For illustrations of inspections between a connector and body ground,
information about the body ground is not shown in the illustration.
IN
IN–46
INTRODUCTION – HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED SYSTEMS
ELECTRONIC CIRCUIT INSPECTION
PROCEDURE
1.
IN
INCORRECT
INCORRECT
CORRECT
D100803E01
Looseness of
Crimping
Core Wire
Terminal
Deformation
Pull Lightly
D100734E01
BASIC INSPECTION
(a) WHEN MEASURING RESISTANCE OF
ELECTRONIC PARTS
(1) Unless otherwise stated, all resistance
measurements should be made at an ambient
temperature of 20°C (68°F). Resistance
measurements may be inaccurate if measured
at high temperatures, i.e. immediately after the
vehicle has been running. Measurements should
be made after the engine has cooled down.
(b) HANDLING CONNECTORS
(1) When disconnecting a connector, first squeeze
the mating halves tightly together to release the
lock, and then press the lock claw and separate
the connector.
(2) When disconnecting a connector, do not pull on
the harnesses. Grasp the connector directly and
separate it.
(3) Before connecting a connector, check that there
are no deformed, damaged, loose or missing
terminals.
(4) When connecting a connector, press firmly until
it locks with a "click" sound.
(5) If checking a connector with a TOYOTA
electrical tester, check the connector from the
backside (harness side) using a mini test lead.
NOTICE:
• As a waterproof connector cannot be
checked from the backside, check it by
connecting a sub-harness.
• Do not damage the terminals by moving
the inserted tester needle.
(c) CHECKING CONNECTORS
(1) Checking when a connector is connected:
Squeeze the connector together to confirm that
they are fully connected and locked.
(2) Checking when a connector is disconnected:
Check by pulling the wire harness lightly from
the backside of the connector. Look for
unlatched terminals, missing terminals, loose
crimps or broken conductor wires. Check
visually for corrosion, metallic or foreign matter
and water, and bent, rusted, overheated,
contaminated, or deformed terminals.
INTRODUCTION – HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED SYSTEMS
IN–47
(3) Checking the contact pressure of the terminal:
Prepare a spare male terminal. Insert it into a
female terminal, and check for ample tension
when inserting and after full engagement.
NOTICE:
When testing a gold-plated female terminal,
always use a gold-plated male terminal.
D100735
(d) REPAIR METHOD OF CONNECTOR TERMINAL
(1) If there is any foreign matter on the terminal,
clean the contact point using an air gun or cloth.
Never rub the contact point using sandpaper as
the plating may come off.
(2) If there is abnormal contact pressure, replace
the female terminal. If the male terminal is goldplated (gold color), use a gold-plated female
terminal; if it is silver-plated (silver color), use a
silver-plated female terminal.
(3) Damaged, deformed, or corroded terminals
should be replaced. If the terminal does not lock
into the housing, the housing may have to be
replaced.
INCORRECT
CORRECT
D100736E01
INCORRECT
(e) HANDLING OF WIRE HARNESS
(1) If removing a wire harness, check the wiring and
clamping before proceeding so that it can be
restored in the same way.
(2) Never twist, pull or slacken the wire harness
more than necessary.
(3) The wire harness should never come into
contact with a high temperature part, or rotating,
moving, vibrating or sharp-edged parts. Avoid
contact with panel edges, screw tips and other
sharp items.
(4) When installing parts, never pinch the wire
harness.
(5) Never cut or break the cover of the wire harness.
If it is cut or broken, replace it or repair it with
vinyl tape.
INCORRECT
INCORRECT
D100784E01
2.
Fig. 1
ECU
C OPEN B
1
2
1
2
A
1
2
1
2
SENSOR
D100785E01
CHECK FOR OPEN CIRCUIT
(a) For an open circuit in the wire harness in Fig. 1,
check the resistance or voltage, as described below.
IN
IN–48
INTRODUCTION – HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED SYSTEMS
Fig. 2
ECU
(b) Check the resistance.
(1) Disconnect connectors A and C, and measure
the resistance between them.
Standard resistance (Fig. 2)
Tester Connection
1
2
IN
SENSOR
1
2
C
1
2
A
B
D100786E01
Fig. 3
ECU
Specified Condition
Connector A terminal 1 - Connector
C terminal 1
10 kΩ or higher
Connector A terminal 2 - Connector
C terminal 2
Below 1 Ω
HINT:
Measure the resistance while lightly shaking the
wire harness vertically and horizontally.
If the results match the examples above, an
open circuit exists between terminal 1 of
connector A and terminal 1 of connector C.
(2) Disconnect connector B and measure the
resistance between the connectors.
Standard resistance (Fig. 3)
Tester Connection
SENSOR
1
1
2
1
2
B1
2
B2
C
1
2
A
D100787E01
Fig. 4
SENSOR 0 V
2
C
5V
5V 1
2
2
B
ECU
1
2
A
D100788E01
Specified Condition
Connector A terminal 1 - Connector
B1 terminal 1
Below 1 Ω
Connector B2 terminal 1 - Connector
C terminal 1
10 kΩ or higher
If the results match the examples above, an
open circuit exists between terminal 1 of
connector B2 and terminal 1 of connector C.
(c) Check the voltage.
(1) In a circuit in which voltage is applied to the ECU
connector terminal, an open circuit can be
checked by conducting a voltage check.
With each connector still connected, measure
the voltage between the body ground and these
terminals (in this order): 1) terminal 1 of
connector A, 2) terminal 1 of connector B, and 3)
terminal 1 of connector C.
Standard voltage (Fig. 4)
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
Connector A terminal 1 - Body
ground
5V
Connector B terminal 1 - Body
ground
5V
Connector C terminal 1 - Body
ground
Below 1 V
If the results match the examples above, an
open circuit exists in the wire harness between
terminal 1 of connector B and terminal 1 of
connector C.
INTRODUCTION – HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED SYSTEMS
3.
Fig. 5
ECU
SHORT
1
2
1
2
C
IN–49
CHECK FOR SHORT CIRCUIT
(a) If the wire harness is ground shorted (Fig. 5), locate
the section by conducting a resistance check with
the body ground (below).
1
2
IN
A
B
D100789E01
(b) Check the resistance with the body ground.
(1) Disconnect connectors A and C, and measure
the resistance.
Standard resistance (Fig. 6)
Fig. 6
ECU
Tester Connection
SENSOR
1
2
1
2
C
B
1
2
A
Specified Condition
Connector A terminal 1 - Body
ground
Below 1 Ω
Connector A terminal 2 - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
D100790E01
HINT:
Measure the resistance while lightly shaking the
wire harness vertically and horizontally.
If the results match the examples above, a short
circuit exists between terminal 1 of connector A
and terminal 1 of connector C.
(2) Disconnect connector B and measure the
resistance.
Standard resistance (Fig. 7)
Fig. 7
Tester Connection
ECU
SENSOR
1
2
C
1
2
B2
1
2
B1
1
2
A
Specified Condition
Connector A terminal 1 - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
Connector B2 terminal 1 - Body
ground
Below 1 Ω
D100800E01
4.
If the results match the examples above, a short
circuit exists between terminal 1 of connector B2
and terminal 1 of connector C.
CHECK AND REPLACE ECU
NOTICE:
• The connector should not be disconnected from
the ECU. Perform the inspection from the
backside of the connector on the wire harness
side.
• When no measuring condition is specified,
perform the inspection with the engine stopped
and the power switch ON (IG).
• Check that the connectors are fully seated. Check
for loose, corroded or broken wires.
IN–50
INTRODUCTION – HOW TO TROUBLESHOOT ECU CONTROLLED SYSTEMS
Example:
Ground
IN
D100801E01
(2) Disconnect the ECU connector. Check the
ground terminal on the ECU side and wire
harness side for bending, corrosion or foreign
matter. Lastly, check the contact pressure of the
female terminals.
ECU Side
Wire Harness Side
(a) First, check the ECU ground circuit. If it is faulty,
repair it. If it is normal, the ECU could be faulty.
Temporarily replace the ECU with a normally
functioning one and check if the symptoms occur. If
the trouble symptoms disappear, replace the
original ECU.
(1) Measure the resistance between the ECU
ground terminal and body ground.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
Ground
Ground
D100802E02
IN–51
INTRODUCTION – TERMS
TERMS
ABBREVIATIONS USED IN MANUAL
ABBREVIATIONS
MEANING
1st
First
2nd
Second
2WD
Two Wheel Drive Vehicle (4 x 2)
3rd
Third
4th
Fourth
4WD
Four Wheel Drive Vehicle (4 x 4)
4WS
Four Wheel Steering System
5th
Fifth
A.D.D.
Automatic Disconnecting Differential
A/C
Air Conditioner
A/F
Air-Fuel Ratio
A/T, ATM
Automatic Transmission (Transaxle)
ABS
Anti-Lock Brake System
AC
Alternating Current
ACC
Accessory
ACIS
Acoustic Control Induction System
ACM
Active Control Engine Mount
ACSD
Automatic Cold Start Device
AFS
Adaptive Front-Lighting System
AHC
Active Height Control Suspension
AID
Air Injection Control Driver
ALR
Automatic Locking Retractor
ALT
Alternator
AMP
Amplifier
ANT
Antenna
APPROX.
Approximately
ASSB
Assembly Services Sdn. Bhd.
ASSY
Assembly
ATF
Automatic Transmission Fluid
AUTO
Automatic
AUX
Auxiliary
AVG
Average
AVS
Adaptive Variable Suspension
B/L
Bi-Level
B/S
Bore-Stroke Ratio
B+
Battery Voltage
BA
Brake Assist
BACS
Boost Altitude Compensation System
BAT
Battery
BDC
Bottom Dead Center
BTDC
Before Top Dead Center
BVSV
Bimetallic Vacuum Switching Valve
C/V
Check Valve
Calif.
California
CAN
Controller Area Network
CB
Circuit Breaker
IN
IN–52
INTRODUCTION – TERMS
ABBREVIATIONS
IN
MEANING
CCo
Catalytic Converter For Oxidation
CCV
Canister Closed Valve
CD
Compact Disc
CF
Cornering Force
CG
Center Of Gravity
CH
Channel
CKD
Complete Knock Down
COMB.
Combination
CPE
Coupe
CPS
Combustion Pressure Sensor
CPU
Central Processing Unit
CRS
Child Restraint System
CTR
Center
CV
Control Valve
CW
Curb Weight
D/INJ
Direct Injection
DC
Direct Current
DEF
Defogger
DFL
Deflector
DIFF.
Differential
DIFF. LOCK
Differential Lock
DLC
Data Link Connector
DLI
Distributorless Ignition
DOHC
Double Overhead Camshaft
DP
Dash Pot
DS
Dead Soak
DSP
Digital Signal Processor
DTC
Diagnostic Trouble Code
DVD
Digital Versatile Disc
E/G
Engine
EBD
Electronic Brake Force Distribution
EC
Electrochromic
ECAM
Engine Control And Measurement System
ECD
Electronically Controlled Diesel
ECDY
Eddy Current Dynamometer
ECT
Electronic Controlled Automatic Transmission/Transaxle
ECU
Electronic Control Unit
ED
Electro-Deposited Coating
EDIC
Electronic Diesel Injection Control
EDU
Electronic Driving Unit
EFI
Electronic Fuel Injection
EGR
Exhaust Gas Recirculation
EGR-VM
EGR-Vacuum Modulator
ELR
Emergency Locking Retractor
EMPS
Electric Motor Power Steering
ENG
Engine
ES
Easy & Smooth
ESA
Electronic Spark Advance
ETCS-i
Electronic Throttle Control System-intelligent
IN–53
INTRODUCTION – TERMS
ABBREVIATIONS
MEANING
EVAP
Evaporative Emission Control
EVP
Evaporator
E-VRV
Electric Vacuum Regulating Valve
EX
Exhaust
F/G
Fuel Gauge
F/P
Fuel Pump
F/W
Flywheel
FE
Fuel Economy
FF
Front-Engine Front-Wheel-Drive
FIPG
Formed In Place Gasket
FL
Fusible Link
FPU
Fuel Pressure Up
FR / Fr
Front
FW/D
Flywheel Damper
FWD
Front-Wheel-Drive
GAS
Gasoline
GND
Ground
GPS
Global Positioning System
GSA
Gear Shift Actuator
H/B
Hatchback
H-FUSE
High Current Fuse
HI
High
HID
High Intensity Discharge (Headlight)
HPU
Hydraulic Power Unit
HSG
Housing
HT
Hard Top
HV
Hybrid Vehicle
HWS
Heated Windshield System
I/P
Instrument Panel
IC
Integrated Circuit
IDI
Indirect Diesel Injection
IFS
Independent Front Suspension
IG
Ignition
IIA
Integrated Ignition Assembly
IN
Intake (Manifold, Valve)
INT
Intermittent
IRS
Independent Rear Suspension
ISC
Idle Speed Control
J/B
Junction Block
J/C
Junction Connector
KD
Kick-Down
L/H/W
Length, Height, Width
LAN
Local Area Network
LB
Liftback
LCD
Liquid Crystal Display
LED
Light Emitting Diode
LH
Left-Hand
LHD
Left-Hand Drive
LIN
Local Interconnect Network
IN
IN–54
INTRODUCTION – TERMS
ABBREVIATIONS
IN
MEANING
LLC
Long-Life Coolant
LNG
Liquefied Natural Gas
LO
Low
LPG
Liquefied Petroleum Gas
LSD
Limited Slip Differential
LSP & BV
Load Sensing Proportioning and Bypass Valve
LSPV
Load Sensing Proportioning Valve
M/T, MTM
Manual Transmission (Transaxle)
MAP
Manifold Absolute Pressure
MAX.
Maximum
MG1
Motor Generator No. 1
MG2
Motor Generator No. 2
MIC
Microphone
MIL
Malfunction Indicator Lamp
MIN.
Minimum
MMT
Multi-mode Manual Transmission
MP
Multipurpose
MPI
Multipoint Electronic Injection
MPX
Multiplex Communication System
MT
Mount
MTG
Mounting
N
Neutral
NA
Natural Aspiration
NO. / No.
Number
O/D
Overdrive
O/S
Oversize
O2S
Oxygen Sensor
OC
Oxidation Catalyst
OCV
Oil Control Valve
OEM
Original Equipment Manufacturing
OHC
Overhead Camshaft
OHV
Overhead Valve
OPT
Option
ORVR
On-board Refueling Vapor Recovery
P & BV
Proportioning And Bypass Valve
P/W
Power Window
PBD
Power Back Door
PCS
Power Control System
PCV
Positive Crankcase Ventilation
PKB
Parking Brake
PPS
Progressive Power Steering
PROM
Programmable Read Only Memory
PS
Power Steering
PSD
Power Slide Door
PTC
Positive Temperature Coefficient
PTO
Power Take-Off
PZEV
Partial Zero Emission Vehicle
R&P
Rack and Pinion
R/B
Relay Block
IN–55
INTRODUCTION – TERMS
ABBREVIATIONS
R/F
MEANING
Reinforcement
RAM
Random Access Memory
RBS
Recirculating Ball Type Steering
RFS
Rigid Front Suspension
RH
Right-Hand
RHD
Right-Hand Drive
RLY
Relay
ROM
Read Only Memory
RR / Rr
Rear
RRS
Rigid Rear Suspension
RSE
Rear Seat Entertainment
RWD
Rear-Wheel Drive
SC
Supercharger
SCV
Swirl Control Valve
SDN
Sedan
SEN
Sensor
SICS
Starting Injection Control System
SOC
State Of Charge
SOHC
Single Overhead Camshaft
SPEC
Specification
SPI
Single Point Injection
SRS
Supplemental Restraint System
SSM
Special Service Materials
SST
Special Service Tools
STD
Standard
STJ
Cold-Start Fuel Injection
SW
Switch
SYS
System
T/A
Transaxle
T/M
Transmission
TACH
Tachometer
TAM
P.T. TOYOTA-Astra Motor
TASA
TOYOTA Argentina S.A.
TAT
TOYOTA Motor Thailand Co. Ltd.
TAW
TOYOTA Auto Works Co. Ltd.
TBI
Throttle Body Electronic Fuel Injection
TC
Turbocharger
TCCS
TOYOTA Computer-Controlled System
TCV
Timing Control Valve
TDC
Top Dead Center
TDV
TOYOTA de Venezuela C.A.
TEMP.
Temperature
TEMS
TOYOTA Electronic Modulated Suspension
TFT
TOYOTA Free-Tronic
TIS
Total Information System For Vehicle Development
TKM
TOYOTA Kirloskar Motor Ltd.
TMC
TOYOTA Motor Corporation
TMMIN
P.T. TOYOTA Motor Manufacturing Indonesia
TMMK
TOYOTA Motor Manufacturing Kentucky, Inc.
IN
IN–56
INTRODUCTION – TERMS
ABBREVIATIONS
TMP
IN
MEANING
TOYOTA Motor Philippines Corp.
TMT
TOYOTA Motor Thailand Co. Ltd.
TRAC
Traction Control System
TRC
Traction Control System
TSAM
TOYOTA South Africa Motors (Pty) Ltd.
TURBO
Turbocharge
TWC
Three-Way Catalyst
U/D
Underdrive
U/S
Undersize
VCV
Vacuum Control Valve
VDIM
Vehicle Dynamics Integrated Management
VENT
Ventilator
VGRS
Variable Gear Ratio Steering
VIM
Vehicle Interface Module
VIN
Vehicle Identification Number
VPS
Variable Power Steering
VSC
Vehicle Stability Control
VSV
Vacuum Switching Valve
VTV
Vacuum Transmitting Valve
VVT-i
Variable Valve Timing-intelligent
W/ / w/
With
W/H
Wire Harness
W/O / w/o
Without
WGN
Wagon
IN–57
INTRODUCTION – TERMS
GLOSSARY OF SAE AND TOYOTA
TERMS
This glossary lists all SAE-J1930 terms and abbreviations
used in this manual in compliance with SAE
recommendations, as well as their TOYOTA equivalents.
SAE
ABBREVIATIONS
3GR
SAE TERMS
Third Gear
TOYOTA TERMS ( )-ABBREVIATIONS
-
4GR
Fourth Gear
-
A/C
Air Conditioning
Air Conditioner
ACL
Air Cleaner
Air Cleaner, A/CL
AIR
Secondary Air Injection
Air Injection (AI)
AP
Accelerator Pedal
-
B+
Battery Positive Voltage
+B, Battery Voltage
BARO
Barometric Pressure
HAC
CAC
Charge Air Cooler
Intercooler
CARB
Carburetor
Carburetor
CFI
Continuous Fuel Injection
-
CKP
Crankshaft Position
Crank Angle
CL
Closed Loop
Closed Loop
CMP
Camshaft Position
Cam Angle
CPP
Clutch Pedal Position
-
CTOX
Continuous Trap Oxidizer
-
CTP
Closed Throttle Position
LL ON, Idle ON
DFI
Direct Fuel Injection
Direct Injection (DI/INJ)
DI
Distributor Ignition
-
DLC3
Data Link Connector 3
OBD II Diagnostic Connector
DTC
Diagnostic Trouble Code
Diagnostic Trouble Code
DTM
Diagnostic Test Mode
-
ECL
Engine Coolant Level
-
ECM
Engine Control Module
Engine Electronic Control Unit (ECU)
ECT
Engine Coolant Temperature
Coolant Temperature, Water Temperature (THW)
EEPROM
Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory
Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory
(EEPROM)
EFE
Early Fuel Evaporation
Cold Mixture Heater (CMH), Heat Control Valve (HCV)
EGR
Exhaust Gas Recirculation
Exhaust Gas Recirculation (EGR)
EI
Electronic Ignition
Distributorless Ignition (DLI)
EM
Engine Modification
Engine Modification (EM)
EPROM
Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory
Programmable Read Only Memory (PROM)
EVAP
Evaporative Emission
Evaporative Emission Control (EVAP)
FC
Fan Control
-
FEEPROM
Flash Electrically Erasable Programmable Read Only
Memory
-
FEPROM
Flash Erasable Programmable Read Only Memory
-
FF
Flexible Fuel
-
FP
Fuel Pump
Fuel Pump
GEN
Generator
Alternator
GND
Ground
Ground (GND)
HO2S
Heated Oxygen Sensor
Heated Oxygen Sensor (HO2S)
IAC
Idle Air Control
Idle Speed Control (ISC)
IN
IN–58
INTRODUCTION – TERMS
SAE
ABBREVIATIONS
IN
SAE TERMS
TOYOTA TERMS ( )-ABBREVIATIONS
IAT
Intake Air Temperature
Intake or Inlet Air Temperature
ICM
Ignition Control Module
-
IFI
Indirect Fuel Injection
Indirect Injection (IDL)
IFS
Inertia Fuel-Shutoff
-
ISC
Idle Speed Control
-
KS
Knock Sensor
Knock Sensor
MAF
Mass Airflow
Air Flow Meter
MAP
Manifold Absolute Pressure
Manifold Pressure Intake Vacuum
MC
Mixture Control
Electric Bleed Air Control Valve (EBCV)
Mixture Control Valve (MCV)
Electric Air Control Valve (EACV)
MDP
Manifold Differential Pressure
-
MFI
Multiport Fuel Injection
Electronic Fuel Injection (EFI)
MIL
Malfunction Indicator Lamp
Check Engine Lamp
MST
Manifold Surface Temperature
-
MVZ
Manifold Vacuum Zone
-
NVRAM
Non-Volatile Random Access Memory
-
O2S
Oxygen Sensor
Oxygen Sensor, O2 Sensor (O2S)
OBD
On-Board Diagnostic
On-Board Diagnostic System (OBD)
OC
Oxidation Catalytic Converter
Oxidation Catalyst Converter (OC), CCo
OL
Open Loop
Open Loop
PAIR
Pulsed Secondary Air Injection
Air Suction (AS)
PCM
Powertrain Control Module
-
PNP
Park/Neutral Position
-
PROM
Programmable Read Only Memory
-
PSP
Power Steering Pressure
-
PTOX
Periodic Trap Oxidizer
Diesel Particulate Filter (DPF)
Diesel Particulate Trap (DPT)
RAM
Random Access Memory
Random Access Memory (RAM)
RM
Relay Module
-
ROM
Read Only Memory
Read Only Memory (ROM)
RPM
Engine Speed
Engine Speed
SC
Supercharger
Supercharger
SCB
Supercharger Bypass
E-ABV
SFI
Sequential Multiport Fuel Injection
Electronic Fuel Injection (EFI), Sequential Injection
SPL
Smoke Puff Limiter
-
SRI
Service Reminder Indicator
-
SRT
System Readiness Test
-
ST
Scan Tool
-
TB
Throttle Body
Throttle Body
TBI
Throttle Body Fuel Injection
Single Point Injection
Central Fuel Injection (Ci)
TC
Turbocharger
Turbocharger
TCC
Torque Converter Clutch
Torque Converter
TCM
Transmission Control Module
Transmission ECU, ECT ECU
TP
Throttle Position
Throttle Position
TR
Transmission Range
-
TVV
Thermal Vacuum Valve
Bimetallic Vacuum Switching Valve (BVSV)
Thermostatic Vacuum Switching Valve (TVSV)
IN–59
INTRODUCTION – TERMS
SAE
ABBREVIATIONS
SAE TERMS
TOYOTA TERMS ( )-ABBREVIATIONS
TWC
Three-Way Catalytic Converter
Three-Way Catalytic (TWC)
Manifold Converter
CCRO
TWC+OC
Three-Way + Oxidation Catalytic Converter
CCR + CCo
VAF
Volume Airflow
Air Flow Meter
VR
Voltage Regulator
Voltage Regulator
VSS
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Vehicle Speed Sensor
WOT
Wide Open Throttle
Full Throttle
WU-OC
Warm Up Oxidation Catalytic Converter
-
WU-TWC
Warm Up Three-Way Catalytic Converter
-
IN
INSTRUMENT PANEL – INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
IP–1
INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY
PAD
PRECAUTION
1.
PRECAUTION FOR VEHICLE WITH SRS AIRBAG
AND SEAT BELT PRETENSIONER
(a) Some operations in this section may affect the SRS
airbags. Prior to performing the corresponding
operations, read the SRS airbag NOTICE (see page
RS-1).
IP
IP–2
INSTRUMENT PANEL – INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
COMPONENTS
NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL SPEAKER PANEL
SUB-ASSEMBLY (w/ JBL Sound System)
FRONT PILLAR GARNISH RH
FRONT PILLAR GARNISH CORNER PIECE RH
FRONT PILLAR GARNISH LH
FRONT PILLAR GARNISH CORNER PIECE LH
D
D
D
INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
IP
A
20 (204, 15)
A
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL END
CLOCK ASSEMBLY
MULTI-DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B126622E05
IP–3
INSTRUMENT PANEL – INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
INSTRUMENT PANEL HOLE COVER
GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR
INSTRUMENT PANEL HOLE COVER
UPPER INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL
SUB-ASSEMBLY
NO. 2 INSTRUMENT PANEL
REGISTER ASSEMBLY
NO. 4 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY
NO. 3 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY
INSTRUMENT PANEL CUSHION
NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER ASSEMBLY
GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR STOPPER SUB-ASSEMBLY
E
E
LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR ASSEMBLY
B126623E01
IP
IP–4
INSTRUMENT PANEL – INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
TELLTALE LIGHT ASSEMBLY
D
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER
FINISH PANEL ASSEMBLY
D
D
D
D
D
NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL D
MOUNTING BRACKET
D
D
D
D
D
D
NAVIGATION ANTENNA ASSEMBLY
(w/ Navigation System)
D
D
D
FRONT PASSENGER
AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
AUTOMATIC LIGHT CONTROL SENSOR
(w/ Daytime Running Light System)
NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL CUSHION
IP
INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
NO. 2 INSTRUMENT PANEL CUSHION
NO. 5 INSTRUMENT PANEL CUSHION
NO. 3 INSTRUMENT PANEL CUSHION
NO. 4 INSTRUMENT PANEL CUSHION
COOLER (SOLAR SENSOR) THERMISTOR
NO. 2 INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
B126624E04
IP–5
INSTRUMENT PANEL – INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
REMOVAL
1.
TABLE OF BOLT, SCREW AND NUT
HINT:
All bolts, screws and nuts relevant to installing and
removing the instrument panel are shown along with an
alphabetical code in the table below.
mm (in.) (L = Length)
Code
Shape
Code
φ= 8
(0.31)
L=20
(0.79)
φ= 5
(0.20)
L=14
(0.55)
Shape
Code
φ= 5
(0.20)
L=16
(0.63)
φ= 5
(0.20)
L=18
(0.71)
Shape
φ= 5
(0.20)
L=14
(0.55)
B074072E03
B074044E02
2.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
3.
REMOVE NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY
(a) Detach the 2 claws and 4 clips, and remove the
instrument panel register.
IP
IP–6
INSTRUMENT PANEL – INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
4.
REMOVE LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 screws.
(b) Disconnect the hood lock control cable.
(c) Detach the 4 claws and 5 clips.
(d) Disconnect all connectors and remove the
instrument panel finish panel.
5.
REMOVE UPPER INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Detach the 3 claws and 4 clips.
(b) Disconnect the connector and remove the
instrument panel finish panel.
6.
REMOVE NO. 3 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY
(a) Detach the claw and 5 clips.
(b) Disconnect the connector and remove the
instrument panel register.
7.
REMOVE NO. 4 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY
(a) Detach the 6 clips and remove the instrument panel
register.
B074045E02
B074046E02
IP
B074047E02
B074048E02
INSTRUMENT PANEL – INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
IP–7
8.
REMOVE NO. 2 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY
(a) Detach the 2 claws and 4 clips, and remove the
instrument panel register.
9.
REMOVE MULTI-DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
B074049E02
10. REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR STOPPER
SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Holding the part indicated in the illustration, remove
the glove compartment door stopper from the glove
compartment door.
B074050E01
11. REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR
ASSEMBLY
(a) While pushing in the sides of the glove compartment
door as indicated by the arrows in the illustration,
open the door to release it from the 2 stoppers.
(b) Open the door until it is horizontal.
B074051E02
(c) Pull the glove compartment door toward the rear of
the vehicle to detach the 2 hinges and remove the
glove compartment door.
12. REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL CUSHION
13. REMOVE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL
END
B074052E02
14. REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL HOLE COVER
(a) Using a screwdriver, remove the 2 instrument panel
hole covers.
15. REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR
(a) Remove the 2 screws.
(b) Detach the claw and 2 clips, and remove the glove
compartment door.
16. REMOVE NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL SPEAKER
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY (w/ JBL Sound System)
17. REMOVE FRONT PILLAR GARNISH CORNER PIECE
LH (See page IR-19)
B074053E02
IP
IP–8
INSTRUMENT PANEL – INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
18. REMOVE FRONT PILLAR GARNISH CORNER PIECE
RH (See page IR-19)
19. REMOVE FRONT PILLAR GARNISH LH (See page IR18)
20. REMOVE FRONT PILLAR GARNISH RH (See page IR18)
21. DISCONNECT PASSENGER AIRBAG CONNECTOR
22. REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
(a) Remove the 3 screws.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts.
(c) Pull up the instrument panel to detach the 6 claws
and 3 clips.
(d) Remove the instrument panel.
IP
B075862E02
DISASSEMBLY
B074055E02
1.
REMOVE NO. 2 INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
(a) Detach the 9 clamps and remove the instrument
panel wire.
2.
REMOVE COOLER (SOLAR SENSOR) THERMISTOR
3.
REMOVE AUTOMATIC LIGHT CONTROL SENSOR
(w/ Daytime Running Light System)
INSTRUMENT PANEL – INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
IP–9
4.
REMOVE TELLTALE LIGHT ASSEMBLY
(a) Detach the 2 claws and remove the telltale light.
5.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL
ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 8 screws and instrument cluster finish
panel.
6.
REMOVE COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 5 screws and combination meter.
7.
REMOVE NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL MOUNTING
BRACKET
(a) Remove the 3 screws and instrument panel
mounting bracket.
B074056E02
B074057E01
B074058E01
8.
REMOVE NAVIGATION ANTENNA ASSEMBLY (w/
Navigation System)
9.
REMOVE FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
10. REMOVE NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL CUSHION
B074059E01
11. REMOVE NO. 2 INSTRUMENT PANEL CUSHION
12. REMOVE NO. 3 INSTRUMENT PANEL CUSHION
13. REMOVE NO. 4 INSTRUMENT PANEL CUSHION
14. REMOVE NO. 5 INSTRUMENT PANEL CUSHION
IP
IP–10
INSTRUMENT PANEL – INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL NO. 5 INSTRUMENT PANEL CUSHION
2.
INSTALL NO. 4 INSTRUMENT PANEL CUSHION
3.
INSTALL NO. 3 INSTRUMENT PANEL CUSHION
4.
INSTALL NO. 2 INSTRUMENT PANEL CUSHION
5.
INSTALL NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL CUSHION
6.
INSTALL FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
7.
INSTALL NAVIGATION ANTENNA ASSEMBLY (w/
Navigation System)
8.
INSTALL NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL MOUNTING
BRACKET
(a) Install the instrument panel mounting bracket with
the 3 screws.
9.
INSTALL COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the combination meter with the 5 screws.
B074059E04
B074058E03
10. INSTALL INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL
ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the instrument cluster finish panel with the 8
screws.
IP
B074057E03
INSTRUMENT PANEL – INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
IP–11
11. INSTALL TELLTALE LIGHT ASSEMBLY
(a) Attach the 2 claws to install the telltale light.
12. INSTALL AUTOMATIC LIGHT CONTROL SENSOR (w/
Daytime Running Light System)
13. INSTALL COOLER (SOLAR SENSOR) THERMISTOR
B074056E03
14. INSTALL NO. 2 INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
(a) Attach the 9 clamps to install the instrument panel
wire.
B074055E03
IP
IP–12
INSTRUMENT PANEL – INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
(a) Attach the 6 claws and 3 clips to install the
instrument panel.
(b) Install the 2 bolts.
(c) Install the 3 screws.
B075862E03
IP
2.
CONNECT PASSENGER AIRBAG CONNECTOR
3.
INSTALL FRONT PILLAR GARNISH LH (See page IR18)
4.
INSTALL FRONT PILLAR GARNISH RH (See page IR17)
5.
INSTALL FRONT PILLAR GARNISH CORNER PIECE
LH (See page IR-19)
6.
INSTALL FRONT PILLAR GARNISH CORNER PIECE
RH (See page IR-19)
7.
INSTALL NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL SPEAKER
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY (w/ JBL Sound System)
8.
INSTALL GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR
(a) Attach the claw and 2 clips to install the glove
compartment door.
(b) Install the 2 screws.
9.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL HOLE COVER
(a) Install the 2 instrument panel hole covers.
10. INSTALL INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL
END
B074053E03
11. INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL CUSHION
INSTRUMENT PANEL – INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
IP–13
12. INSTALL GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Attach the 2 hinges to install the door.
(b) While pushing in the sides of the glove compartment
door as indicated by the arrows in the illustration,
engage it to the 2 stoppers.
13. INSTALL GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR STOPPER
SUB-ASSEMBLY
14. INSTALL MULTI-DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
B074051E03
15. INSTALL NO. 2 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY
(a) Attach the 2 claws and 4 clips to install the
instrument panel register.
B074049E03
16. INSTALL NO. 4 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY
(a) Attach the 6 clips to install the instrument panel
register.
B074048E03
17. INSTALL NO. 3 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY
(a) Connect the connector.
(b) Attach the claw and 5 clips to install the instrument
panel register.
B074047E03
IP
IP–14
INSTRUMENT PANEL – INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
18. INSTALL UPPER INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Connect the connector.
(b) Attach the 3 claws and 4 clips to install the
instrument panel finish panel.
B074046E03
19. INSTALL LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Connect the connectors.
(b) Attach the 4 claws and 5 clips to install the
instrument panel finish panel.
(c) Connect the hood lock control cable.
(d) Install the 2 screws.
B074045E03
20. INSTALL NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY
(a) Attach the 2 claws and 4 clips to install the
instrument panel register.
21. CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
IP
B074044E03
22. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
23. CHECK SRS WARNING LIGHT
(a) Check the SRS warning light (see page RS-31).
IP–14
INSTRUMENT PANEL – LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL
LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL
PRECAUTION
1.
IP
PRECAUTION FOR VEHICLE WITH SRS AIRBAG
AND SEAT BELT PRETENSIONER
(a) Some operations in this section may affect the SRS
airbags. Prior to performing the corresponding
operations, read the SRS airbag NOTICE (see page
RS-1).
IP–15
INSTRUMENT PANEL – LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL
COMPONENTS
COWL SIDE TRIM BOARD RH
INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL LOWER
FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH
NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL UNDER
COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
CLAMP
INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL LOWER CENTER
STEERING COLUMN COVER
SPIRAL CABLE
SUB-ASSEMBLY
50 (510, 37)
NO. 2 STEERING
WHEEL COVER LOWER
COWL SIDE TRIM BOARD LH
2.0 (20, 18 in.*lbf)
TILT LEVER BRACKET
NO. 3 STEERING WHEEL
COVER LOWER
FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY
B126626E02
IP
IP–16
INSTRUMENT PANEL – LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL
NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL
CUSHION LOWER
F
LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL
SUB-ASSEMBLY
F
F
G
B
F
GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR LOCK ASSEMBLY
B
H
B
B
G
B
NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL
CUSHION LOWER
GLOVE COMPARTMENT PLATE
B
12 (122, 9)
B
GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR LOCK COVER
SHIFT LEVER ASSEMBLY LOWER
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
POWER STEERING ECU
RADIO RECEIVER
(w/ Cassette Tape Player)
IP
RADIO RECEIVER
(w/o Cassette Tape Player)
NO. 1 CENTER CLUSTER CUSHION
B
B
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL ASSEMBLY CENTER
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B126625E02
IP–17
INSTRUMENT PANEL – LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL
REMOVAL
1.
TABLE OF BOLT, SCREW AND NUT
HINT:
All bolts, screws and nuts relevant to installing and
removing the instrument panel are shown along with an
alphabetical code in the table below.
mm (in.) (L = Length)
Code
Shape
Code
φ=8
(0.31)
L = 20
(0.79)
φ=5
(0.20)
L = 14
(0.55)
φ=6
(0.24)
L = 16
(0.63)
Shape
Code
φ=5
(0.20)
L = 16
(0.63)
φ=5
(0.20)
L = 18
(0.71)
Shape
φ=5
(0.20)
L = 14
(0.55)
φ=6
(0.24)
L = 20
(0.79)
φ=6
(0.24)
L = 20
(0.79)
B074073E02
2.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
3.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
(a) Remove the instrument panel (see page IP-5).
4.
REMOVE NO. 2 STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER
5.
REMOVE NO. 3 STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER
6.
REMOVE STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY (See page RS268)
7.
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL ASSEMBLY (See page
SR-8)
8.
REMOVE TILT LEVER BRACKET (See page SR-8)
9.
REMOVE STEERING COLUMN COVER (See page
SR-8)
10. REMOVE SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page
RS-278)
IP
IP–18
INSTRUMENT PANEL – LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL
11. REMOVE FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH (See page
IR-7)
12. REMOVE FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH (See page
IR-7)
13. REMOVE COWL SIDE TRIM BOARD LH (See page IR7)
14. REMOVE COWL SIDE TRIM BOARD RH (See page
IR-7)
15. REMOVE INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL
ASSEMBLY CENTER
(a) Remove the 2 screws.
(b) Detach the 4 clips and remove the instrument
cluster finish panel.
16. REMOVE NO. 1 CENTER CLUSTER CUSHION
17. REMOVE RADIO RECEIVER
B074060E02
18. REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL
LOWER CENTER
(a) Using a clip remover, remove the clip from the
instrument panel finish panel lower center.
(b) Detach the 4 claws and 2 clips, and remove the
instrument panel finish panel.
B074061E02
19. REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR LOCK
COVER
(a) Detach the 6 claws and remove the glove
compartment door lock cover.
IP
B074062E02
20. REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR LOCK
ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 4 screws and glove compartment door
lock.
B074063E01
IP–19
INSTRUMENT PANEL – LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL
21. REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL
LOWER
(a) Detach the 4 claws and remove the instrument
panel finish panel.
B074064E02
22. REMOVE NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL UNDER
COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Detach the 2 claws and remove the instrument
panel under cover.
23. REMOVE POWER STEERING ECU
24. REMOVE SHIFT LEVER ASSEMBLY LOWER
B074065E02
25. REMOVE LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Using a clip remover, remove the 8 clips from the
duct and lower instrument panel.
(b) Remove the 6 bolts.
(c) Remove the 2 screws.
(d) Disconnect all connectors, and detach all clamps.
(e) Remove the instrument panel.
IP
B074066E01
IP–20
INSTRUMENT PANEL – LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL
DISASSEMBLY
IP
1.
REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT PLATE
(a) Remove the 2 screws.
(b) Detach the 2 claws and remove the glove
compartment plate.
2.
REMOVE NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL CUSHION
LOWER
INSTRUMENT PANEL – LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL
IP–21
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL CUSHION
LOWER
2.
INSTALL GLOVE COMPARTMENT PLATE
(a) Attach the 2 claws to install the glove compartment
door.
(b) Install the 2 screws.
IP
IP–22
INSTRUMENT PANEL – LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Install the instrument panel.
(b) Connect all the connectors and attach all the
clamps.
(c) Install the 2 screws.
(d) Install the 6 bolts.
(e) Install the 8 clips to the duct and lower instrument
panel.
B074066E06
IP
B074065E03
2.
INSTALL SHIFT LEVER ASSEMBLY LOWER
3.
INSTALL POWER STEERING ECU
4.
INSTALL NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL UNDER COVER
SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Attach the 2 claws to install the instrument panel
under cover.
INSTRUMENT PANEL – LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL
IP–23
5.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL
LOWER
(a) Attach the 4 claws to install the instrument panel
finish panel.
6.
INSTALL GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR LOCK
ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the glove compartment door lock with the 4
screws.
7.
INSTALL GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR LOCK
COVER
(a) Attach the 6 claws to install the glove compartment
door lock cover.
8.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL
LOWER CENTER
(a) Attach the 4 claws and 2 clips to install the
instrument panel finish panel.
(b) Install the clip.
B074064E03
B074063E03
B074062E03
9.
INSTALL RADIO RECEIVER
10. INSTALL NO. 1 CENTER CLUSTER CUSHION
B074061E03
11. INSTALL INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL
ASSEMBLY CENTER
(a) Attach the 4 claws and 2 clips to install the
instrument cluster finish panel.
(b) Install the 2 screws.
12. INSTALL COWL SIDE TRIM BOARD LH (See page IR19)
B074060E03
13. INSTALL COWL SIDE TRIM BOARD RH (See page IR19)
IP
IP–24
INSTRUMENT PANEL – LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL
14. INSTALL FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH (See page
IR-19)
15. INSTALL FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH (See page
IR-19)
16. INSTALL SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page
RS-278)
17. INSTALL STEERING COLUMN COVER (See page SR14)
18. INSTALL TILT LEVER BRACKET (See page SR-14)
19. INSTALL STEERING WHEEL ASSEMBLY (See page
SR-15)
20. INSTALL STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY (See page RS269)
21. INSTALL NO. 3 STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER
22. INSTALL NO. 2 STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER
23. INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
(a) Install the instrument panel (see page IP-11).
24. CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
25. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
26. CHECK SRS WARNING LIGHT
(a) Check the SRS warning light (see page RS-31).
IP
IP–23
INSTRUMENT PANEL – REAR CONSOLE BOX
REAR CONSOLE BOX
INSTRUMENT PANEL
BODY
COMPONENTS
CONSOLE BOX POCKET
UPPER CONSOLE PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
CONSOLE BOX CARPET
INSTRUMENT PANEL CUP HOLDER
REAR CONSOLE COMPARTMENT
DOOR SUB-ASSEMBLY
REAR CONSOLE BOX SUB-ASSEMBLY
IP
REAR POWER POINT SOCKET COVER
REAR POWER POINT SOCKET ASSEMBLY
REAR CONSOLE BOX
CUP HOLDER
NO. 4 INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
CONSOLE REAR END PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
B126627E03
IP–24
INSTRUMENT PANEL – REAR CONSOLE BOX
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE UPPER CONSOLE PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Pull the console panel sub-assembly upper upwards
and disengage the 2 claws.
(b) Detach the 4 clips and remove the console panel.
B074080E02
(c) Remove the 4 screws and instrument panel cup
holder.
2.
REMOVE CONSOLE BOX POCKET
3.
REMOVE CONSOLE BOX CARPET
4.
REMOVE CONSOLE REAR END PANEL SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Pull up the console rear end panel sub-assembly in
the direction indicated by the arrow to detach the 6
clips, and remove the console rear end panel.
B074082E01
B074085E02
(b) Remove the 4 screws and rear console box cup
holder.
IP
B074086E01
5.
B074083E01
REMOVE REAR CONSOLE BOX SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 screws, 2 bolts and console box.
INSTRUMENT PANEL – REAR CONSOLE BOX
IP–25
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE NO. 4 INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
2.
REMOVE REAR POWER POINT SOCKET ASSEMBLY
3.
REMOVE REAR POWER POINT SOCKET COVER
4.
REMOVE REAR CONSOLE COMPARTMENT DOOR
SUB-ASSEMBLY
HINT:
While the console compartment door sub-assembly rear
is part of the console box, it may be replaced on its own.
Refer to the procedure below when removing it.
(a) Remove the 4 screws and console compartment
door.
NOTICE:
If the screws are removed while the door is
closed, the hinge spring may cause the screws
to fly out. Because of this, be sure to remove the
screws while the door is open.
B074087E01
REASSEMBLY
B074087E03
1.
INSTALL REAR CONSOLE COMPARTMENT DOOR
SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the console compartment door with the 4
screws.
2.
INSTALL REAR POWER POINT SOCKET COVER
3.
INSTALL REAR POWER POINT SOCKET ASSEMBLY
4.
INSTALL NO. 4 INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL REAR CONSOLE BOX SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the console box with the 2 screws and 2
bolts.
IP
B074083E03
2.
B074086E03
INSTALL CONSOLE REAR END PANEL SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Install the rear console box cup holder with the 4
screws.
IP–26
INSTRUMENT PANEL – REAR CONSOLE BOX
(b) Attach the 6 clips to install the console rear end
panel.
3.
INSTALL CONSOLE BOX CARPET
4.
INSTALL CONSOLE BOX POCKET
5.
INSTALL UPPER CONSOLE PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the instrument panel cup holder with the 4
screws.
B074085E04
B074082E03
(b) Attach the 4 clips and 2 claws to install the console
panel.
B074080E03
IP
INTERIOR – FRONT FLOOR FOOTREST
IR–1
FRONT FLOOR FOOTREST
INTERIOR
BODY
COMPONENTS
CLIP
FRONT FLOOR FOOTREST
B132598E02
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE FRONT FLOOR FOOTREST
(a) Using a screwdriver, detach the 2 clips and remove
the footrest.
IR
B074185E02
IR–2
INTERIOR – FRONT FLOOR FOOTREST
INSTALLATION
1.
B074185E02
IR
INSTALL FRONT FLOOR FOOTREST
(a) Attach the 2 clips to install the footrest.
IR–3
INTERIOR – ROOF HEADLINING
ROOF HEADLINING
INTERIOR
BODY
COMPONENTS
TONNEAU COVER ASSEMBLY
BACK DOOR WEATHERSTRIP
REAR NO. 3
FLOOR BOARD
REAR NO. 2
FLOOR BOARD
ROPE HOOK
REAR DECK
TRIM COVER
ROPE HOOK
REAR NO. 4
FLOOR BOARD
REAR NO. 1
FLOOR BOARD
REAR SIDE SEATBACK
FRAME RH
DECK FLOOR BOX LH
REAR DECK FLOOR BOX
IR
REAR SIDE SEATBACK
FRAME LH
REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY
B132617E02
IR–4
INTERIOR – ROOF HEADLINING
FRONT DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP LH
CENTER PILLAR GARNISH LH
ROOF SIDE INNER
GARNISH ASSEMBLY LH
FRONT PILLAR GARNISH LH
REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP LH
FRONT PILLAR GARNISH
CORNER PIECE LH
42 (430, 31)
COWL SIDE TRIM
BOARD LH
42 (430, 31)
FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
IR
LAP BELT OUTER ANCHOR
COVER
FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT
ASSEMBLY LH
REAR SEAT 3 POINT TYPE BELT
ASSEMBLY LH
DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY LH
REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
CENTER PILLAR LOWER GARNISH LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B132592E03
IR–5
INTERIOR – ROOF HEADLINING
CENTER PILLAR GARNISH RH
REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM WEATHERSTRIP RH
FRONT DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP RH
DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY RH
FRONT PILLAR GARNISH
CORNER PIECE RH
ROOF SIDE INNER GARNISH
ASSEMBLY RH
FRONT PILLAR GARNISH RH
42 (430, 31)
42 (430, 31)
REAR SEAT 3 POINT TYPE BELT
ASSEMBLY RH
COWL SIDE TRIM
BOARD RH
FRONT DOOR SCUFF
PLATE RH
CENTER PILLAR LOWER GARNISH RH
REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH
LAP BELT OUTER ANCHOR COVER
IR
FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY RH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B132591E02
IR–6
INTERIOR – ROOF HEADLINING
NO. 3 ROOF
SILENCER PAD
ROOF HEADLINING PAD
NO. 2 ROOF
SILENCER PAD
ASSIST GRIP SUB-ASSEMBLY
ROOF HEADLINING ASSEMBLY
ASSIST GRIP
COVER
ASSIST GRIP
COVER
CLIP
NO. 1 ROOM LIGHT ASSEMBLY
MAP LIGHT ASSEMBLY
VISOR HOLDER
IR
NO. 1 ROOM
LIGHT LENS
ASSIST GRIP COVER
VISOR ASSEMBLY RH
VISOR ASSEMBLY LH
ASSIST GRIP COVER
ASSIST GRIP
SUB-ASSEMBLY
B132597E02
IR–7
INTERIOR – ROOF HEADLINING
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
(a) Using a screwdriver, detach the 8 claws and 2 clips,
and remove the scuff plate.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
3.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
4.
REMOVE COWL SIDE TRIM BOARD LH
(a) Using a screwdriver, detach the claw and 2 clips,
and remove the trim board.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
5.
REMOVE COWL SIDE TRIM BOARD RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
6.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP LH
7.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP RH
8.
REMOVE FRONT PILLAR GARNISH CORNER PIECE
LH
(a) Put protective tape as shown in the illustration.
Standard measurement
B073586E02
B073588E02
B
C
A
A
Protective
Tape
Protective
Tape
B132622E01
Area
Specified Condition
A
2.0 mm (0.079 in.)
B
10.0 mm (0.394 in.)
C
50.0 mm (1.969 in.)
(b) Using a screwdriver, detach the 5 claws and remove
the corner piece.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
9.
REMOVE FRONT PILLAR GARNISH CORNER PIECE
RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
IR
IR–8
INTERIOR – ROOF HEADLINING
10. REMOVE FRONT PILLAR GARNISH LH
(a) w/o Curtain Shield Airbag:
Using a screwdriver, detach the 2 clips and remove
the pillar garnish.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
B073594E03
(b) w/ Curtain Shield Airbag:
Remove the pillar garnish.
(1) Pull the pillar garnish so that clip B detaches,
the base of clip A detaches, and the tip of clip A
locks in the pillar garnish's hole.
(2) Using needle-nose pliers, rotate clip A 90°.
Then pull the pillar garnish to release the tip of
clip A from the pillar garnish.
(3) Pull the pillar garnish in the direction indicated
by the arrow in the illustration to detach the
claw.
Pillar
Garnish
Clip A
Pull
90°
Claw
Clip A
Clip B
B079223E02
120 mm
(4.72 in.)
700 mm (27.56 in.)
Double-sided
Tape
IR
(c) w/ Curtain Shield Airbag:
Protect the curtain shield airbag LH.
(1) Thoroughly cover the airbag with cloth or nylon
that is approximately 700 mm (27.56 in.) x 120
mm (4.72 in.) and fix the ends of the cover with
double-sided tape, as shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
Cover the curtain shield airbag with the
protective cover as soon as the pillar
garnish is removed.
11. REMOVE FRONT PILLAR GARNISH RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
12. REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY (See
page SE-15)
Protective Cover
B076392E04
INTERIOR – ROOF HEADLINING
IR–9
13. REMOVE REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
(a) Using a screwdriver, detach the 6 claws and clip,
and remove the scuff plate.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
14. REMOVE REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
B073587E02
15. REMOVE REAR SIDE SEATBACK FRAME LH
(a) Remove the bolt.
(b) Detach the claw and remove the frame.
16. REMOVE REAR SIDE SEATBACK FRAME RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
17. REMOVE REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP LH
B076393E02
18. REMOVE REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP RH
19. REMOVE LAP BELT OUTER ANCHOR COVER
(a) Using a screwdriver, detach the 3 claws and remove
the anchor cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
20. DISCONNECT FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT
ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the bolt and disconnect the floor anchor.
B076394E03
21. DISCONNECT FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT
ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Remove the bolt and disconnect the floor anchor.
22. REMOVE CENTER PILLAR LOWER GARNISH LH
(a) Using a screwdriver, detach the 2 claws and 2 clips,
and remove the lower garnish.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
23. REMOVE CENTER PILLAR LOWER GARNISH RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
B073589E03
IR
IR–10
INTERIOR – ROOF HEADLINING
24. REMOVE CENTER PILLAR GARNISH LH
(a) Remove the 2 screws.
(b) Using a screwdriver, detach the clip and remove the
pillar garnish.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
25. REMOVE CENTER PILLAR GARNISH RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
B073590E02
26. DISCONNECT REAR SEAT 3 POINT TYPE BELT
ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the bolt and disconnect the floor anchor.
27. DISCONNECT REAR SEAT 3 POINT TYPE BELT
ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Remove the bolt and disconnect the floor anchor.
28. REMOVE BACK DOOR WEATHERSTRIP
29. REMOVE TONNEAU COVER ASSEMBLY
30. REMOVE REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD
31. REMOVE REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD
32. REMOVE REAR NO. 4 FLOOR BOARD
33. REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX
34. REMOVE DECK FLOOR BOX LH
Rope Hook
Clip
Clip
35. REMOVE REAR NO. 1 FLOOR BOARD
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and the 2 rope hooks.
(b) Using a clip remover, remove the 2 clips.
(c) Using a screwdriver, detach the 5 clips and remove
the floor board.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
B132619E01
IR
36. REMOVE REAR DECK TRIM COVER
(a) Using a screwdriver, detach the 4 claws and remove
the trim cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
B076395E02
INTERIOR – ROOF HEADLINING
IR–11
37. REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the screw and 2 bolts.
(b) Using a clip remover, remove the clip.
(c) Using a screwdriver, detach the 7 claws and 3 clips,
and remove the side panel.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
Clip
B073591E02
38. REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Remove the screw and 2 bolts.
(b) Using a clip remover, remove the clip.
(c) Using a screwdriver, detach the 6 claws and 2 clips,
and remove the side panel.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
Clip
B079224E02
39. REMOVE ROOF SIDE INNER GARNISH ASSEMBLY
LH
(a) Using a screwdriver, detach the 6 clips and claw,
and remove the inner garnish.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
B073592E03
40. REMOVE ROOF SIDE INNER GARNISH ASSEMBLY
RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
IR
IR–12
INTERIOR – ROOF HEADLINING
41. REMOVE MAP LIGHT ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 screws.
(b) Using a moulding remover, detach the 4 clips and
remove the map light.
(c) Disconnect the map light connector.
B076771E02
42. REMOVE NO. 1 ROOM LIGHT ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a screwdriver, detach the 4 claws and remove
the room light lens.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
Protective Tape
Claw
Claw
Claw
Claw
B076772E03
(b) Using a screwdriver, detach the 4 claws and remove
the room light.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(c) Disconnect the room light connector.
B073597E02
43. REMOVE ASSIST GRIP COVER
(a) Using a screwdriver, detach the 4 claws and remove
the 2 covers.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
IR
B076398E04
INTERIOR – ROOF HEADLINING
IR–13
44. REMOVE ASSIST GRIP SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a screwdriver, detach the 4 claws and remove
the assist grip.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
B076399E02
45. REMOVE VISOR ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the 2 screws.
(b) Disconnect the connector and remove the visor.
46. REMOVE VISOR ASSEMBLY RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
B075287E01
47. REMOVE VISOR HOLDER
(a) Remove the visor holder by turning it
counterclockwise.
90q
B050596E01
48. REMOVE ROOF HEADLINING ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 3 clips and headlining.
(b) Remove the silencer pads and headlining pad from
the headlining.
(c) Remove the wire harness.
B073598E02
IR
IR–14
INTERIOR – ROOF HEADLINING
INSTALLATION
HINT:
A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the standard
bolt chart (see page SS-2).
1.
INSTALL ROOF HEADLINING ASSEMBLY
(a) Align the markings, and then install the wire harness
with tape.
NOTICE:
Attach the roof wire harness securely.
(b) Install the silencer pads and headlining pad to the
headlining.
B076400E01
(c) Install the headlining with the 3 clips.
2.
INSTALL VISOR HOLDER
(a) Install the visor holder and turn it clockwise.
3.
INSTALL VISOR ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Connect the connector.
B073598E02
(b) Install the visor with the 2 screws.
4.
INSTALL VISOR ASSEMBLY RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
5.
INSTALL ASSIST GRIP SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Attach the 4 claws to install the assist grip.
B075287E01
IR
B076399E03
INTERIOR – ROOF HEADLINING
6.
INSTALL ASSIST GRIP COVER
(a) Attach the 4 claws to install the 2 covers.
7.
INSTALL NO. 1 ROOM LIGHT ASSEMBLY
(a) Connect the room light connector.
IR–15
B076398E03
(b) Attach the 4 claws to install the room light.
B073597E02
(c) Attach the 4 claws to install the room light lens.
8.
Claw
Claw
INSTALL MAP LIGHT ASSEMBLY
(a) Connect the map light connector.
Claw
Claw
B076772E04
(b) Attach the 4 clips to install the map light.
(c) Install the 2 screws.
IR
B076771E03
IR–16
INTERIOR – ROOF HEADLINING
9.
INSTALL ROOF SIDE INNER GARNISH ASSEMBLY
LH
(a) Attach the 6 clips and claw to install the inner
garnish.
10. INSTALL ROOF SIDE INNER GARNISH ASSEMBLY
RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
B073592E03
11. REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Attach the 7 claws and 3 clips to install the side
panel.
(b) Install the clip, screw and 2 bolts.
Clip
B073591E02
12. INSTALL DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Attach the 6 claws and 2 clips to install the side
panel.
(b) Install the clip, screw and 2 bolts.
Clip
IR
B079224E02
13. INSTALL REAR DECK TRIM COVER
(a) Attach the 4 claws to install the trim cover.
B076395E02
INTERIOR – ROOF HEADLINING
IR–17
14. INSTALL REAR NO. 1 FLOOR BOARD
(a) Attach the 5 clips to install the floor board.
(b) Install the 2 clips, 2 bolts and 2 rope hooks.
Rope Hook
Clip
15. INSTALL DECK FLOOR BOX LH
Clip
16. INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX
17. INSTALL REAR NO. 4 FLOOR BOARD
18. INSTALL REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD
19. INSTALL REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD
20. INSTALL TONNEAU COVER ASSEMBLY
21. INSTALL BACK DOOR WEATHERSTRIP
B132619E01
22. DISCONNECT REAR SEAT 3 POINT TYPE BELT
ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Connect the floor anchor with the bolt.
Torque: 42 N*m (430 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
23. DISCONNECT REAR SEAT 3 POINT TYPE BELT
ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Connect the floor anchor with the bolt.
Torque: 42 N*m (430 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
24. INSTALL CENTER PILLAR GARNISH LH
(a) Attach the clip to install the pillar garnish.
(b) Install the 2 screws.
25. INSTALL CENTER PILLAR GARNISH RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
B073590E02
26. INSTALL CENTER PILLAR LOWER GARNISH LH
(a) Attach the 2 claws and 2 clips to the lower garnish.
27. INSTALL CENTER PILLAR LOWER GARNISH RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
B073589E03
28. DISCONNECT FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT
ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Connect the floor anchor with the bolt.
Torque: 42 N*m (430 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
29. DISCONNECT FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT
ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Connect the floor anchor with the bolt.
Torque: 42 N*m (430 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
IR
IR–18
INTERIOR – ROOF HEADLINING
30. INSTALL LAP BELT OUTER ANCHOR COVER
(a) Attach the 3 claws to install the anchor cover.
31. INSTALL REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP LH
32. INSTALL REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP RH
B076394E03
33. INSTALL REAR SIDE SEATBACK FRAME LH
(a) Attach the claw to install the frame.
(b) Install the bolt.
34. INSTALL REAR SIDE SEATBACK FRAME RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
B132620
35. INSTALL REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
(a) Attach the 6 claws and clip to install the scuff plate.
36. INSTALL REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
37. INSTALL REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY (See
page SE-23)
B073587E02
38. INSTALL FRONT PILLAR GARNISH LH
(a) w/o Curtain Shield Airbag:
Attach the 2 clips to install the pillar garnish.
(b) w/ Curtain Shield Airbag:
Remove the protective cover.
IR
B073594E03
IR–19
INTERIOR – ROOF HEADLINING
(c) w/ Curtain Shield Airbag:
Install the pillar garnish.
(1) Set the claws of the pillar garnish to the area
labeled C.
(2) Insert the tip of clip A into the pillar garnish's
hole.
(3) Using needle-nose pliers, rotate the tip of clip A
90°. Then push the pillar garnish toward the
vehicle body to attach the base of clip A and
clip B.
Pillar Garnish
Clip A
90°
Clip A
39. INSTALL FRONT PILLAR GARNISH RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
Clip B
C
B132621E01
B
40. INSTALL FRONT PILLAR GARNISH CORNER PIECE
LH
(a) Put protective tape as shown in the illustration.
Standard measurement
C
A
A
Protective
Tape
Area
Specified Condition
A
2.0 mm (0.079 in.)
B
10.0 mm (0.394 in.)
C
50.0 mm (1.969 in.)
(b) Attach the 5 claws to install the corner piece.
Protective
Tape
41. INSTALL FRONT PILLAR GARNISH CORNER PIECE
RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
42. INSTALL FRONT DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP LH
43. INSTALL FRONT DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP RH
IR
B136013E01
44. INSTALL COWL SIDE TRIM BOARD LH
(a) Attach the claw and 2 clips to install the trim board.
45. INSTALL COWL SIDE TRIM BOARD RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
B073588E02
IR–20
INTERIOR – ROOF HEADLINING
46. INSTALL FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
(a) Attach the 8 claws and 2 clips to install the scuff
plate.
47. INSTALL FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
48. DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
B073586E02
IR
49. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
IR–20
INTERIOR – FUEL LID LOCK CONTROL
FUEL LID LOCK CONTROL
INTERIOR
BODY
COMPONENTS
REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY
REAR SIDE SEATBACK
ASSEMBLY LH
FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY LH
ROOF SIDE INNER GARNISH
ASSEMBLY LH
CENTER PILLAR LOWER GARNISH LH
DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL
ASSEMBLY LH
REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
IR
FRONT DOOR SCUFF
PLATE LH
FUEL LID LOCK CONTROL CABLE
SUB-ASSEMBLY
FUEL FILLER OPENING LID
LOCK RETAINER
FUEL LID LOCK OPEN LEVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
B132593E03
INTERIOR – FUEL LID LOCK CONTROL
IR–21
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
2.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the seat (see page SE-4).
3.
REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY (See
page SE-15)
4.
REMOVE REAR SIDE SEATBACK ASSEMBLY LH
(See page SE-15)
5.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH (See page
IR-7)
6.
REMOVE REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH (See page
IR-9)
7.
REMOVE CENTER PILLAR LOWER GARNISH LH
(See page IR-9)
8.
REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY LH
(See page IR-11)
9.
REMOVE ROOF SIDE INNER GARNISH ASSEMBLY
LH (See page IR-11)
10. REMOVE FUEL LID LOCK OPEN LEVER SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the screw while holding the lever.
(b) Disconnect the cable and remove the lever.
Lever
B074573E01
IR
IR–22
INTERIOR – FUEL LID LOCK CONTROL
11. REMOVE FUEL LID LOCK CONTROL CABLE SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the cable from the clamps at the location
shown in the illustration.
Cable
Cable
Cable
Cable
Cable
Cable
Cable
B075120E02
(b) Push the claw and pull out the cable.
Cable
IR
Push
B073318E04
INTERIOR – FUEL LID LOCK CONTROL
IR–23
12. REMOVE FUEL FILLER OPENING LID LOCK
RETAINER
(a) Turn the lock retainer counterclockwise and remove
the lock retainer as shown in the illustration.
B073319E02
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL FUEL FILLER OPENING LID LOCK
RETAINER
(a) Install the lock retainer and turn it clockwise as
shown in the illustration.
2.
INSTALL FUEL LID LOCK CONTROL CABLE SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Attach the claw and install the cable to the lock
retainer.
Turn
Retainer
B073320E03
Cable
Claw
B073318E05
IR
IR–24
INTERIOR – FUEL LID LOCK CONTROL
(b) Connect the cable from the clamps at the location
shown in the illustration.
Cable
Cable
Cable
Cable
Cable
Cable
Cable
B075120E02
3.
INSTALL FUEL LID LOCK OPEN LEVER SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Connect the cable to the lever.
(b) Install the lever with the screw.
Lever
B074573E01
IR
4.
INSTALL ROOF SIDE INNER GARNISH ASSEMBLY
LH (See page IR-15)
5.
INSTALL DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY LH
(See page IR-15)
6.
INSTALL CENTER PILLAR LOWER GARNISH LH
(See page IR-17)
7.
INSTALL REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH (See page
IR-18)
8.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH (See page
IR-19)
9.
INSTALL REAR SIDE SEATBACK ASSEMBLY LH
(See page SE-22)
10. INSTALL REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY (See
page SE-23)
11. INSTALL FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the seat (see page SE-10).
12. CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
INTERIOR – FUEL LID LOCK CONTROL
IR–25
13. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
IR
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
LI–1
LIGHTING SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
1.
PRECAUTION FOR DISCONNECTING BATTERY
CABLE
NOTICE:
FOR INITIALIZATION:
When disconnecting the cable from the negative (-)
battery terminal, initialize the following system(s)
after the cable is reconnected.
System Name
See procedure
Power Window Control System
IN-32
2.
3.
NOTICE:
FOR HYBRID SYSTEM ACTIVATION:
• When the warning light is illuminated or the
battery has been disconnected and reconnected,
pressing the power switch may not start the
system on the first try. If so, press the power
switch again.
• With the power switch's power mode changed to
ON (IG), disconnect the battery. If the key is not in
the key slot during reconnection, DTC B2799 may
be output.
PRECAUTION OF HEADLIGHT BULB
REPLACEMENT (w/o HID)
(a) If even a thin film of oil is left on the surface of the
halogen light, its service life will be shortened
because the light will burn at a higher temperature.
(b) Handle any halogen light with great care. Dropping,
hitting or damaging the bulb in any way may result
in it exploding and shattering because the internal
pressure is high.
(c) Always prepare a new bulb for immediate
replacement. While replacing the bulb, the lens may
attract dust and moisture if removed from the
vehicle for too long.
(d) Always use a bulb of the same wattage for
replacement.
(e) Firmly reinstall the socket after bulb replacement.
The lens may become cloudy or the light cavity may
fill with water through the gaps around the socket.
PRECAUTION FOR HEADLIGHT BULB
REPLACEMENT (w/ HID)
(a) When any defects such as deformation, cracks,
dents, chipping, etc. are identified on the HID
headlight (especially, on the light control ECU),
replace it with a new one.
(b) Even if the operation seems to be normal, the failsafe function may be defective.
LI
LI–2
LI
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
(c) Be careful not to scratch or drop bulbs of the HID
headlight and halogen bulbs (for high beam
headlights and fog lights) as they have pressurized
gas inside and can be easily broken.
(d) Touching the high voltage socket of the HID
headlight with the headlight dimmer switch on could
generate a momentary voltage of 20,000 V and lead
to a serious injury.
(e) Never connect a tester to the high voltage socket of
the HID headlight for measurement, as this may
lead to a serious injury because of high voltage.
(f) When servicing the HID headlight, keep it away
from water, turn off the light control switch, and
disconnect the battery terminal and the connector of
the light control ECU in advance to avoid electric
shock.
(g) When operating the HID headlight, operate it after
assembly is completed and never turn on the lights
without a bulb installed.
(h) Do not turn on the HID headlight using a power
source other than the vehicle's.
LI–3
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
HEADLIGHT ASSEMBLY RH
- HEADLIGHT (LOW)
- HEADLIGHT (HIGH)
- CLEARANCE LIGHT
- SIDE MARKER LIGHT
- LIGHT CONTROL ECU*
- HEADLIGHT BEAM LEVEL
CONTROL ACTUATOR*
VISOR ASSEMBLY LH (VANITY LIGHT SWITCH LH)
VISOR ASSEMBLY RH (VANITY LIGHT SWITCH RH)
VANITY LIGHT RH
PERSONAL LIGHT
(OVERHEAD JUNCTION BLOCK)
VANITY LIGHT LH
NO. 1 ROOM LIGHT ASSEMBLY
(INTERIOR LIGHT)
ENGINE ROOM NO. 2
RELAY BLOCK
- FR FOG RELAY
FRONT DOOR
COURTESY
LIGHT RH
FRONT DOOR COURTESY LIGHT LH
FRONT FOG LIGHT
ASSEMBLY RH
FRONT FOG LIGHT
ASSEMBLY LH
*: w/ HID
ENGINE ROOM RELAY BLOCK AND JUNCTION BLOCK
- INTEGRATION RELAY (BACK-UP RELAY)
- DIM RELAY
- H-LP RELAY
HEADLIGHT ASSEMBLY LH - DRL NO. 4 RELAY
- T-LP RELAY
- HEADLIGHT (LOW)
- HAZ FUSE
- HEADLIGHT (HIGH)
- FR FOG FUSE
- CLEARANCE LIGHT
- H-LP HI FUSE
- SIDE MARKER LIGHT
- H-LP LO FUSE
- LIGHT CONTROL ECU*
- HEADLIGHT BEAM LEVEL
CONTROL ACTUATOR*
I102176E02
LI
LI–4
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
HIGH-MOUNTED STOP LIGHT
REAR DOOR COURTESY LIGHT SWITCH ASSEMBLY RH
REAR COMBINATION LIGHT
ASSEMBLY RH
- TAILLIGHT
- STOP LIGHT
- TURN SIGNAL LIGHT
- BACK-UP LIGHT
FRONT DOOR LOCK ASSEMBLY RH
- DOOR UNLOCK DETECTION SWITCH RH
FRONT DOOR COURTESY
LIGHT SWITCH ASSEMBLY RH
LI
FRONT DOOR LOCK ASSEMBLY LH
- DOOR UNLOCK DETECTION
SWITCH LH
LICENSE PLATE LIGHT
FRONT DOOR COURTESY
LIGHT SWITCH ASSEMBLY LH
REAR DOOR COURTESY
LIGHT SWITCH ASSEMBLY LH
LUGGAGE ROOM
COMPARTMENT LIGHT
REAR COMBINATION
LIGHT ASSEMBLY LH
- TAILLIGHT
- STOP LIGHT
- TURN SIGNAL LIGHT
- BACK-UP LIGHT
LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT
DOOR LOCK
- LUGGAGE COMPARTMENT
LIGHT SWITCH
REAR HEIGHT CONTROL
SENSOR LH
I102177E02
LI–5
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY
COMBINATION SWITCH
- LIGHT CONTROL SWITCH
- HEADLIGHT DIMMER SWITCH
- TURN SIGNAL SWITCH
- FOG LIGHT SWITCH
AUTOMATIC LIGHT CONTROL SENSOR
COMBINATION METER
- HEADLIGHT LEVELING WARNING*
LI
GLOVE BOX LIGHT
GATEWAY ECU
DLC3
HEADLIGHT
BEAM LEVEL
CONTROL ECU*
STOP LIGHT SWITCH
DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
- MAIN BODY ECU
- TURN SIGNAL FLASHER RELAY
- TAIL FUSE
- STOP FUSE
HAZARD WARNING
SIGNAL SWITCH
PARKING BRAKE SWITCH
*: w/ HID
I102178E02
LI–6
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
Main Body ECU
IG1 Relay
ACC Relay
Headlight Dimmer Switch
LI
Courtesy Light Switch
Door Unlock Detection Switch
Automatic Light Control Sensor
Headlight (Low)
H-LP Relay
Headlight (High)
DIM Relay
Driver Side
Junction Block
(Main Body ECU)
DRL NO. 4 Relay
Daytime Running Light Relay
Front Fog Light
Taillight
FR Fog Relay
T-LP Relay
Each Illumination
I102179E03
LI–7
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
Main Body ECU
Courtesy Light
Room Light, Key Slot Light
Luggage Compartment Light
Driver Side
Junction Block
(Main Body ECU)
DLC3
LI
BEAN
Gateway ECU
HV ECU
CAN
Skid Control ECU
I102180E02
LI–8
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
Headlight Beam Level Control ECU
H-LP Relay
Height Control Sensor
Headlight Beam
Level Control ECU
Combination Meter
LI
Headlight Beam Level Control Actuator
DLC3
I102182E02
Input and output signal of each ECU
Transmitter
Receiving
Signal
Communication Method
HV ECU
Body ECU
Ready condition signal
CAN - BEAN
Skid Control ECU
Body ECU
Parking brake switch signal
CAN - BEAN
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
LI–9
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
Components
PARTS DESCRIPTION
Function
Automatic light control sensor
Detects ambient light and sends information to main body ECU
Hazard warning switch
On or off state is sent to flasher relay
Stop light switch
Sends brake pedal state to rear combination light and high mount stop
light
H-LP relay
Turns headlight on when it is actuated by headlight ON demand signal
via main body ECU
T-LP relay
Turns taillight and illumination on when it is actuated by taillight ON
demand signal via main body ECU
DIM relay
Turns headlight (high beam) on when it is actuated by headlight ON
demand signal via main body ECU
DRL relay
Controls headlight (low beam) when it is actuated by DRL ON demand
signal via main body ECU
Daytime running light relay
Controls headlight (low beam) when it is actuated by DRL ON demand
signal via main body ECU
Door courtesy switch
Detects door open / close state and sends information to respective
main body ECU
Door unlock detection switch
Detects door lock / unlock state and sends information to respective
main body ECU
Headlight beam level control actuator
Moves headlight (low beam) up and down according to the information
from headlight beam level control ECU
Height control sensor
Detects vehicle height and sends corresponding information to
headlight beam level control ECU
Combination meter
Sends headlight level warning according to information from headlight
beam level control ECU
2.
OPERATION DESCRIPTION
(a) Manual lighting system
(1) The main body ECU receives the following:
• Light switch tail signal
• Light switch head signal
• Light switch high beam signal
• Front fog switch signal
• Lighting system passing signal
(2) The main body ECU controls the following
based on the signals listed in (1).
• H-LP relay ON signal
Sent when light switch head signal is
received.
• T-LP relay ON signal
Sent when light switch tail signal and light
switch head signal are received.
• DIM relay ON signal
Sent when light switch high beam signal is
received.
• FR FOG relay ON signal
Sent when light switch tail and front fog
switch signals are received.
(3) The main body ECU controls the on / off
operation of the following based on the signals
listed in (2):
• Headlight (low)
• Headlight (high)
LI
LI–10
LI
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
• Clearance light
• Side marker light
• Front fog light
• Taillight
• License plate light
• Room lights
(b) Automatic lighting system
(1) The main body ECU receives the following:
• Light switch auto signal
• Light control switch signal
(2) The main body ECU controls the following
based on the signals listed in (1):
• H-LP relay ON signal
Sent according to the illuminance information
from the light control signal when the light
switch auto signal is received.
• T-LP relay ON signal
Sent according to the illuminance information
from the light control signal when the light
switch auto signal is received.
(3) The main body ECU controls the on / off
operation of the following based on the signals
listed in (2).
• Headlight (low)
• Clearance light
• Side marker light
• Taillight
• License plate light
(c) Daytime running light system
(1) The main body ECU receives the following:
• Light switch tail signal
• Light switch head signal
• Light switch auto signal
• Light control signal
• Ready condition signal
• Parking brake switch signal
(2) The main body ECU controls the following
based on the signals listed in (1).
• H-LP relay ON signal
Sent when the ready condition signal has
been received but the light switch head and
parking brake switch signals have not been
received.
Sent when the ready condition signal has
been received but the parking brake switch
signal and the illuminance information from
the light control have not been received while
receiving the light switch auto signal.
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
LI–11
• DIM relay ON signal
Sent when the relay condition signal has
been received but the light switch head and
parking brake switch signals have not been
received.
Sent when the ready condition signal has
been received but the parking brake switch
signal and the illuminance information from
the light control have not been received while
receiving the light switch auto signal.
• DRL NO. 4 relay ON signal
Sent when the ready condition signal has
been received but the light switch head and
parking brake switch signals have not been
received.
Sent when the ready condition signal has
been received but the parking brake switch
signal and the illuminance information from
the light control have not been received while
receiving the light switch auto signal.
• PWM output signal
Sent when the ready condition signal has
been received but the light switch tail, light
switch head, and parking brake switch signals
have not been received.
Sent when the ready condition signal has
been received but the parking brake switch
signal and the illuminance information from
the light control have not been received while
receiving the light switch auto signal.
(3) The main body ECU controls the following
based on the signals listed in (2):
• Headlight (Low)
(d) Light auto turn off system
(1) The main body ECU receives the following:
• Light switch tail signal
• Light switch head signal
• Light switch auto signal
• Front fog switch signal
• Power switch signal
• Light control signal
• Driver's seat courtesy switch signal
(2) The main body ECU controls the following
based on the signals listed in (1).
• H-LP relay ON signal
Terminates communication when the power
switch ON (IG) signal terminates and the
driver's seat courtesy switch signal is
received while sending the H-LP relay ON
signal. The H-LP relay ON signal results from
receiving the light switch head signal and
illuminance information from the light control
signal.
LI
LI–12
LI
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
• T-LP relay ON signal
Terminates communication when the power
switch ON (IG) signal terminates and the
driver's seat courtesy switch signal is
received while sending the T-LP relay ON
signal. The T-LP relay ON signal results from
receiving the light switch head signal and
illuminance information from the light control
signal.
(3) The main body ECU controls the on / off
operation of the following based on the signals
listed in (2).
• Headlight (low)
• Headlight (high)
• Clearance light
• Side marker light
• Front fog light
• Taillight
• License plate light
(e) Illuminated entry system
(1) The main body ECU receives the following:
• Driver side door courtesy switch signal
• Front passenger side door courtesy switch
signal
• Rear LH side door courtesy switch signal
• Rear RH side seat door courtesy switch
signal
• Driver side door lock signal
• Passenger side door lock signal (w/ Smart
key system, w/ Theft deterrent system)
• Power switch signal
(2) The main body ECU controls the following
based on the signals listed in (1):
• Illumination ON demand signal
Sent when the respective door courtesy
switch signals are received.
Sent when the respective door lock signals
are received.
Sent when the power switch ON (IG) and
power switch ON (ACC) signals are not
received.
(3) The main body ECU controls on / off and fade-in
/ fade-out operations of the following based on
the signals listed in (2):
• Key slot light
• No. 1 room light
• Personal light (Overhead junction block)
(f) Auto headlight leveling system
(1) The headlight beam level control ECU receives
the following:
• H-LP relay ON signal
• Vehicle height sensor signal
• Vehicle speed signal
LI–13
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
(2) The headlight beam level control ECU controls
the following based on the signals listed in (1).
• Leveling motor operation demand signal.
Sent based on the vehicle height sensor
signal and vehicle speed sensor when the HLP relay ON signal is received.
The headlight beam level control ECU
receives vehicle speed signal and determines
the driving condition according to the table
below, and then starts / terminates controlling
on the headlight leveling actuator.
Vehicle Speed
Mode
Control
Less than 0.7 km/h (0.4 mph)
While stopping
Controls
More than 30 km/h (19 mph) or less than 180
km/h (112 mph)
While driving at constant speed
Controls
More than 30 km/h (19 mph) or less than 180
km/h (112 mph)
While accelerating
Does not control
More than 180 km/h (112 mph)
While driving at high speed
Does not control
More than 0.7 km/h (0.4 mph) or less than 30
km/h (19 mph)
While driving at low speed
Does not control
(3) The headlight beam level control ECU controls
the following based on the signal listed in (2).
• Headlight beam leveling actuator
LI
LI–14
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
• Use these procedures to troubleshoot the lighting system.
• *: Use the intelligent tester.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
INSPECT BATTERY VOLTAGE
LI
Standard voltage:
11 to 14 V
If the voltage is below 11 V, recharge or replace the battery
before proceeding.
NEXT
3
INSPECT COMMUNICATION FUNCTION LARGE-SCALE MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION
SYSTEM (BEAN)*
(a) Use the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to check if the
Multiplex Communication System (MPX) is functioning
normally.
Result
Result
Proceed to
MPX DTC is not output
A
MPX DTC is output (see page MP-16)
B
B
Go to MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION
SYSTEM
A
4
CHECK FOR DTC*
Result
Result
DTC is not output
A
DTC is output (see page LI-30)
B
B
A
Proceed to
Go to step 7
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
5
LI–15
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Result
Result
Proceed to
Fault is not listed in problem symptoms table
A
Fault is listed in problem symptoms table (see page LI-18)
B
B
Go to step 7
A
6
OVERALL ANALYSIS AND TROUBLESHOOTING*
(a) Operation Check (see page LI-14)
(b) Terminals of ECU (see page LI-21)
(c) DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST (see page LI-28)
NEXT
7
REPAIR OR REPLACE
NEXT
8
NEXT
END
CONFIRMATION TEST
LI
LI–16
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
OPERATION CHECK
1.
LI
2.
3.
CHECK ILLUMINATED ENTRY OPERATION
(a) Illumination entry system controls the following:
• Key slot light
• No. 1 room light
(b) Check that the lights turn on after:
(1) Unlocking driver or front passenger door that
was closed and locked with the power switch
OFF.
(c) Check that the lights fade out after:
(1) Leaving the doors unlocked for 15 seconds.
(2) Turning the power switch ON (ACC or IG).
(3) Locking all the doors.
(d) Check that the lights stay on for at least 15 seconds
after opening any of the doors, then fade out again
after 15 seconds.
(e) Check that the lights turn on after:
(1) Closing all the doors and turning the power
switch from ON (ACC or IG) to OFF.
(f) Check that the lights fade out after:
(1) Leaving the doors unlocked for 15 seconds.
(2) Turning the power switch ON (ACC or IG).
(3) Locking all the doors.
(g) Check that the lights stay on for at least 15 seconds
after opening any of the doors, then fade out again
in 15 seconds after closing all the doors.
(h) Check that the lights turn on when opening any of
the doors and fade out after either closing and
locking them or turning the power switch ON (ACC
or IG).
CHECK CONLIGHT SYSTEM OPERATION
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Turn the headlight dimmer switch to the AUTO
position.
(c) Cover the automatic light control sensor and check
that the taillight and headlight turn on in order.
(d) Uncover the automatic light control sensor and
check that the headlight and taillight go off in order.
CHECK LIGHT AUTO TURN OFF SYSTEM
OPERATION
HINT:
Perform the operation check at a location with bright
surroundings.
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and switch the light
control switch into the TAIL or HEAD position when
driver side door is closed.
(b) Turn the power switch OFF and open the driver's
door. Check that the headlight, taillight, and front fog
light go off.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and switch the light
control switch into the AUTO position.
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
4.
5.
LI–17
(d) Turn the power switch OFF and open the driver's
door when the light control switch is in the AUTO
position and headlights remain on by the conlight
system operation. Check that the headlight, taillight,
front fog light go off.
CHECK BATTERY SAVER OPERATION
(a) Check that the all lights go off after approximately
20 minutes with the power switch OFF and driver
door opened.
CHECK DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT OPERATION
(a) Turn the light control switch off, and release the
parking brake with the power switch ON (IG or
READY). Check that the headlight (low beam) dims.
(b) Check that the daytime running light goes off after
turning the power switch OFF or changing the light
control switch to the HEAD position.
(c) Check that the headlight (low beam) dims when
releasing the parking brake under the following
conditions:
• Light control switch is in the AUTO position (with
bright surroundings).
• Conlight system is not operating.
• Power switch is ON (IG).
• Power switch is ON (READY).
(d) Turn the power switch OFF or change the light
control switch to the TAIL or HEAD position. Check
that the headlight (low beam) goes off.
LI
LI–18
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
CUSTOMIZE PARAMETERS
HINT:
The following items can be customized.
NOTICE:
• When the customer requests a change in a function,
first make sure that the function can be customized.
• Be sure to make a note of the current settings before
customizing.
• When troubleshooting a function, first make sure that
the function is set to the default setting.
Illuminated entry
Display (Item)
Default
Contents
Setting
LIGHTING TIME
15 s
Changes lighting time after
closing doors (light quickly fades
out when power switch is turned
ON (IG)
7.5 s / 15 s / 30 s
I/L AUTO OFF
ON
Illumination AUTO OFF ON
function to turn off interior light
automatically after specified time
for prevent the battery loss when
the interior light switch is "DOOR"
position and the door is open
ON / OFF
I/L ON/UNLOCK
ON
Function to light interior light, etc.
when the door is unlocked with a
transmitter, door key or door lock
control switch
ON / OFF
I/L ON/ACC OFF
ON
Illuminates interior light when
power switch is turned from the
ON (ACC) to ON (IG) position
ON / OFF
Display (Item)
Default
Contents
Setting
SENSITIVITY
NORMAL
To adjust sensitivity of lighting
illumination. Refer to the
illustration*1.
LIGHT2 / LIGHT1 / NORMAL /
DARK1 / DARK2
DISP EX ON SEN
NORMAL
Changes brightness when
lowering lights such as
combination meter indicator light,
A/C indicator light, and clock light.
Refer to the illustration*2.
LIGHT2 / LIGHT1 / NORMAL /
DARK1 / DARK2
DISP EX OFF SEN
NORMAL
Changes brightness when
lowering lights such as
combination meter indicator light,
A/C indicator light, and clock.
Refer to the illustration*3.
LIGHT2 / LIGHT1 / NORMAL /
DARK1 / DARK2
DRL FUNCTION (z)
ON
ON / OFF of DRL function
ON / OFF
LI
Light control
z: w/ Daytime running light
Illustration of *1
Brightness of lowering the lights
Dark ←→ Bright
Setting
DARK2 - DARK1 - NORMAL - LIGHT1 - LIGHT2
Illustration of *2
Brightness when canceling the lowering of the lights
Dark ←→ Bright
Setting
DARK2 - DARK1 - NORMAL - LIGHT1 - LIGHT2
Illustration of *3
Lighting brightness
Dark ←→ Bright
Setting
DARK2 - DARK1 - NORMAL - LIGHT1 - LIGHT2
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
LI–19
INITIALIZATION
1.
1
HEADLIGHT BEAM LEVEL CONTROL ECU
INITIALIZATION
NOTICE:
• Initialize the headlight beam level control ECU
when: vehicle height changes by such means as
removal, installation, and replacement of the
height control sensor, replacement of the
suspension, or replacement of the headlight beam
level control ECU assembly.
• Adjust the headlight aim after initializing the
headlight beam level control ECU (see page LI80).
LI
CHECK VEHICLE CONDITION
(a) Leave approximately 10 liters of fuel in the tank (fuel
indicator shows approximately 2 segments).
(b) Unload the vehicle.
(c) Check that there is no passenger in the vehicle.
(d) Turn off the headlights.
NEXT
2
CHECK WARNING INDICATOR
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and check if the warning
indication appears.
Standard:
Master warning in the meter blinks and "AUTO
LEVELING WARNING" appears.
HINT:
Warning indication appears only when replacing with a
new headlight beam level control ECU. Go to "OK" for
removal / installation of the headlight beam level control
ECU, replacement / removal / installation of the height
control sensor, or replacement of the suspension.
NG
OK
CHECK HEADLIGHT BEAM LEVEL
CONTROL ECU, WIRE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
LI–20
3
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
INITIALIZATION
(a) Connect terminals 4 (CG) and 8 (OP3) of the DLC3
using the SST.
(b) Flash the headlight more than 3 times within 20 seconds
using the headlight dimmer switch. Check if the warning
indication appears (step A).
NOTICE:
Flash the headlight at an interval of 1 second
D1
CG
OP3
H100769E68
LI
OK
Action
Warning indication
headlight beam level control ECU replacement (new)
Appears → Disappears (initialization complete)
headlight beam level control ECU removal / installation, height control
sensor replacement / removal / installation, or suspension
replacement
Does not appear → Appears (initialization complete) → Disappears
NG
OK
INITIALIZATION COMPLETE
RETURN TO "CHECK WARNING
INDICATOR" IF INITIALIZATION DOES NOT
SUCCEED AFTER REPEATING STEP A
MORE THAN 20 TIMES
LI–21
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
• Use the table below to help determine the cause of the
problem symptom. The potential causes of the symptoms
are listed in order of probability in the "Suspected area"
column of the table. Check each symptom by checking the
suspected areas in the order they are listed. Replace parts
as necessary.
• Inspect the fuses and relays related to this system before
inspecting the suspected areas below.
Headlight and taillight system
Symptom
Low beam does not turn on (one side)
Low beam does not turn on (both sides)
High beam does not turn on (one side)
High beam does not turn on (both sides)
FLASH does not turn on (Low beam and high beam
are normal)
Headlight is dim
Taillight does not turn on (all)
Taillight does not turn on (one)
Daytime running light system does not operate
Suspected area
See page
1. Bulb
-
2. Wire harness
-
3. Light control computer (HID)
-
1. Light control switch circuit
LI-45
2. Headlight relay circuit
LI-38
3. Main body ECU
-
1. Bulb
-
2. Wire harness
-
1. Light control switch circuit
LI-45
2. Headlight relay circuit
LI-38
3. DRL relay circuit (w/ DRL)
LI-41
4. Main body ECU
-
1. Light control switch circuit
LI-45
2. Main body ECU
-
1. Bulb
-
2. Wire harness
-
1. Light control switch circuit
LI-45
2. TAIL relay circuit
LI-58
3. Main body ECU
-
LI
1. Bulb
-
2. Wire harness
-
1. Light control switch circuit
LI-45
2. Headlight relay circuit
LI-38
3. DRL relay circuit
LI-41
4. Parking brake switch circuit
BC-186
5. Main body ECU
-
Automatic light control system
Symptom
Suspected area
1. Light control switch circuit
Automatic light control system does not operate
See page
LI-45
2. Automatic light control sensor circuit
LI-50
3. Main body ECU
-
Light auto turn off system
Symptom
Light auto turn off system does not operate
Suspected area
See page
1. Light control switch circuit
LI-45
2. Power source circuit
LI-71
3. Door courtesy switch circuit
LI-54
4. Main body ECU
-
LI–22
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
Fog light system
Symptom
Fog light does not turn on (one side)
Fog light does not turn on (both sides)
Suspected area
See page
1. Bulb
-
2. Wire harness
-
1. Headlight dimmer switch
LI-106
2. Wire harness
-
3. Main body ECU
-
Turn signal light and hazard warning system
Symptom
Hazard and turn signal do not turn on
LI
Hazard warning light does not turn on (Turn is normal)
Turn signal does not turn on (Hazard is normal)
Turn signal does not turn on in one direction
Suspected area
See page
1. Turn signal flasher relay
LI-123
2. Wire harness
-
3. Driver side junction block
-
1. Hazard warning
LI-109
2. Wire harness
-
3. Driver side junction block
-
1. Headlight dimmer switch
LI-106
2. Wire harness
-
3. Driver side junction block
-
1. Bulb
-
2. Wire harness
-
3. Driver side junction block
-
Stop light system
Symptom
Stop light does not turn on (one)
Stop light does not turn on (all)
Suspected area
See page
1. Bulb
-
2. Wire harness
-
1. Stop light switch
LI-111
2. Wire harness
-
Illuminated entry system
Symptom
Illuminated entry system controlled by the multiplex
network body ECU does not operate
Suspected area
See page
1. Power source circuit
LI-71
2. Door lock position circuit
LI-56
3. Door courtesy switch circuit
LI-54
4. Main Body ECU
-
Headlight beam level control system
Symptom
Headlight beam level control system does not operate
(warning light turns on)
Headlight beam level control system does not operate
(warning light turns off)
Headlight beam level control system cannot be
canceled during low speed driving (driving condition
cannot be determined)
Suspected area
See page
1. Headlight beam level control ECU power source circuit
LI-61
2. Height control sensor circuit
LI-63
3. Headlight beam level control ECU
-
1. Headlight signal circuit
LI-63
2. Headlight beam level control actuator circuit
LI-61
3. Warning light circuit
LI-69
4. Headlight beam level control ECU
-
1. Vehicle speed signal circuit
LI-35
2. Headlight beam level control ECU
-
Others
Symptom
Vanity light does not turn on
Suspected area
See page
1. Bulb
-
2. Wire harness
-
LI–23
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
Symptom
Suspected area
1. Bulb
Back up light does not turn on
Luggage room light does not turn on
Courtesy light does not turn on
See page
-
2. Back/up relay
-
3. Wire harness
-
1. Bulb
-
2. Wire harness
-
1. Bulb
-
2. Door courtesy light switch
LI-113
2. Wire harness
-
4. Body ECU
-
LI
LI–24
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
for Front Side
CHECK DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK (MAIN
BODY ECU)
1G
1E
1D
LI
1I
1O
1J
1A
1B
for Rear Side
B7
1K
1M
B5
B6
1N
I039971E02
LI–25
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
Tail (1A-15) - GND (1E-17)
BR - W-B
Taillight signal
(To front side marker)
Front RH side marker light
turns on
10 to 14 V
Front RH side marker light
turns off
Below 1 V
ECUB (1A-30) - GND (1E17)
R - W-B
Power source
(From battery)
Always
10 to 14 V
Tail (1A-33) - GND (1E-17)
BR - W-B
Taillight signal
(To front side marker)
Front LH side marker light
turns on
10 to 14 V
Front LH side marker light
turns off
Below 1 V
Rear LH door courtesy
switch signal
Rear LH door is opened
Below 1 V
Rear LH door is closed
10 to 14 V
Luggage room courtesy
switch signal
Luggage room door is
opened
Below 1 V
Luggage room door is
closed
10 to 14 V
License plate light and
rear RH combination light
come on
10 to 14 V
License plate light and
rear RH combination light
go off
Below 1 V
Rear RH door courtesy
switch signal
Rear LH door is opened
Below 1 V
Rear LH door is closed
10 to 14 V
Front LH door courtesy
switch signal
Front LH door is opened
Below 1 V
Front LH door is closed
10 to 14 V
Front RH door courtesy
switch signal
Front RH door is opened
Below 1 V
Front RH door is closed
10 to 14 V
Taillight signal
(To rear combination light)
Rear LH combination light
turns on
Below 1 V
Rear LH combination light
turns off
10 to 14 V
Below 1 V
RCTY (1D-5) - GND (1E17)
R - W-B
BCTY (1D-7) - GND (1E17)
Tail (1D-10) - GND (1E-17)
BR - W-B
RCTY(1D-20) - GND (1E17)
R - W-B
DCTY (1D-21) - GND (1E17)
V - W-B
PCTY (1D-24) - GND (1E17)
BR - W-B
Tail (1D-29) - GND (1E-17)
BR - W-B
Taillight signal
(To license plate light and
rear combination light)
Tail (1E-10) - GND (1E-17)
BR - W-B
Taillight signal
(To each illumination)
Light control switch is in
TAIL or HEAD
Light control switch is OFF
10 to 14 V
GND (1E-17) - Body
ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 V
ILL (1E-27) - GND (1E-17)
B - W-B
Illumination signal circuit
Key slot light turns on
Below 1 V
Key slot light turns off
10 to 14 V
MPX1 (1G-9) - GND (1E17)
GR - W-B
Multiplex communication
signal circuit
Power switch ON (IG)
Signal waveform
HU (1I-4) - GND (1E-17)
P - W-B
Headlight dimmer switch
signal
Headlight dimmer switch
in HIGH
Below 1 V
Headlight dimmer switch
not in HIGH
10 to 14 V
LI
LI–26
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
Tail (1N-7) - GND (1E-17)
GR - W-B
Taillight signal
(To each illumination)
Light control switch is in
TAIL or HEAD
Below 1 V
Light control switch is OFF
10 to 14 V
Below 1 V
Tail (1N-9) - GND (1E-17)
G - W-B
Light control switch is in
TAIL or HEAD
Light control switch is OFF
10 to 14 V
Tail (1M-6) - GND (1E-17)
L - W-B
Light control switch is in
TAIL or HEAD
Below 1 V
Light control switch is OFF
10 to 14 V
Light control switch is in
TAIL or HEAD
Below 1 V
Tail (1M-8) - GND (1E-17)
G - W-B
ILL (1O-2) - GND (1E-17)
L - W-B
Light control switch is OFF
10 to 14 V
Room light turns on
Below 1 V
Room light turns off (When
switch is in DOOR
position)
10 to 14 V
Luggage room light turns
on
Below 1 V
Luggage room light turns
off (When switch is in
DOOR position)
10 to 14 V
Rear door is in lock
position
10 to 14 V
Rear door is in unlock
position
Below 1 V
Front fog light switch
signal circuit
Front fog light switch ON
Below 1 V
Front fog light switch OFF
10 to 14 V
Door courtesy light circuit
Door courtesy light RH
turns on
Below 1 V
Door courtesy light RH
turns off
10 to 14 V
Illumination signal circuit
LI
CYLB (B5-7) - GND (1E17)
LSWR (B5-10) - GND (1E7)
W - W-B
O - W-B
LIB1 (B5-13) - GND (1E17)
SB - W-B
CYPL (B5-14) - GND (1E17)
L - W-B
Luggage room light signal
circuit
Door lock position switch
circuit
MPX2 (B5-15) - GND (1E17)
B - W-B
Multiplex communication
signal circuit
Power switch ON (IG)
Signal waveform
FFOG (B5-17) - GND (1E17)
Y - W-B
Front fog light operation
signal circuit
Front fog light turns on
Below 1 V
Front fog light turns off
10 to 14 V
AUTO (B5-18) - GND (1E17)
W - W-B
Headlight dimmer switch
signal circuit
Light control switch is in
AUTO
Below 1 V
Light control switch is not
in AUTO
10 to 14 V
Door courtesy light LH
turns on
Below 1 V
Door courtesy light LH
turns off
10 to 14 V
Daytime running light does
not operate
10 to 14 V
Daytime running light
operates
Below 1 V
Daytime running light does
not operate
Below 1 V
Daytime running light
operates
10 to 14 V
CYLD (B5-19) - GND (1E17)
PWM1 (B6-3) - GND (1E7)*
HON (B6-12) - GND (1E7)
Y - W-B
SB - W-B
W - W-B
Door courtesy light circuit
Daytime running light
operation signal
Daytime running light
operation signal
CLTE (B6-14) - GND (1E7)
B - W-B
Light control sensor circuit
(Ground circuit)
Always
Below 1 V
CLTS (B6-15) - GND (1E7)
W - W-B
Light control sensor circuit
(Signal circuit)
Power switch ON (IG)
Signal waveform
CLTB (B6-16) - GND (1E7)
R - W-B
Light control sensor circuit
(Power source circuit)
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
LI–27
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
DRL/DIM (B7-2) - GND
(1E-17)
Y - W-B
DIM relay operation signal
Headlight (High beam)
turns on
Below 1 V
Headlight (High beam)
turns off
10 to 14 V
Light control switch is in
HEAD
Below 1 V
Light control switch is not
in HEAD
10 to 14 V
Front RH door is in lock
position
Below 1 V
Front RH door is in unlock
position
10 to 14 V
HEAD (B7-3) - GND (1E17)
LSWP (B7-10) - GND (1E7)
B - W-B
Y - W-B
Headlight dimmer switch
signal circuit
Door lock position switch
circuit
HRLY (B7-20) - GND (1E7)
G - W-B
HEAD relay operation
signal
Headlight turns on
Below 1 V
Headlight turns off
10 to 14 V
TAIL (B7-21) - GND (1E-7)
R - W-B
Headlight dimmer switch
signal circuit
Light control switch is in
TAIL
Below 1 V
Light control switch is not
in TAIL
10 to 14 V
Headlight dimmer switch
is in FLASH
Below 1 V
Headlight dimmer switch
is not in FLASH
10 to 14 V
Front LH door is in lock
position
10 to 14 V
Front LH door is in unlock
position
Below 1 V
HF (B7-22) - GND (1E-7)
LSWD (B7-25) - GND (1E7)
G - W-B
LG - W-B
Door lock position switch
circuit
2.
LI
HINT:
*: w/ Daytime running light
CHECK HEADLIGHT BEAM LEVEL CONTROL ECU
H12
E073014E01
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
IG (H12-1) - E1 (H12-24)
V - W-B
Power source
(From battery)
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
SBR (H12-2) - E1 (H1224)
P - W-B
Height control sensor
(Power source)
Power switch ON (IG)
4.5 to 5.5 V
RHT (H12-3) - E1 (H1224)
W - W-B
Headlight beam level
control actuator RH
(Signal circuit)
1.0 to 12.6 V
(approx. 10 seconds)
LHT (H12-4) - E1 (H12-24)
R - W-B
Headlight beam level
control actuator LH
(Signal circuit)
With power switch ON (IG)
and headlight ON, change
the vehicle height and
maintain height for more
than 2 seconds
SHR (H12-5) - E1 (H1224)
L - W-B
Height control sensor
(Power source)
Power switch ON (IG)
Above 2.5 V
PRST (H12-9) - E1 (H1224)
B - W-B
Initialize signal input
terminal
Above 5.0 V
LI–28
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
HDLP (H12-10) - E1 (H1224)
G - W-B
HEAD relay operate signal
Light control switch is in
HEAD
Below 1 V
Light control switch is mot
HEAD
10 to 14 V
Headlight leveling warning
signal
(To combination meter)
HEADLIGHT LEVELING
is indicated
Below 1 V
HEADLIGHT LEVELING
is not indicated
10 to 14 V
WNG (H12-11) - E1 (H1224)
LI
L - W-B
SPDR (H12-12) - E1 (H1224)
V - W-B
Vehicle speed signal
(From combination meter)
Vehicle is driving at 30 km/
h (18 mph)
Pulse generation
(See waveform 1)
RH+ (H12-13) - E1 (H1224)
B - W-B
Headlight beam level
control actuator RH
(Power source circuit)
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
LH+ (H12-14) - E1 (H1224)
G - W-B
Headlight beam level
control actuator LH
(Power source circuit)
SGR (H12-20) - E1 (H1224)
Y - W-B
Height control sensor
(Ground circuit)
Always
Below 1 V
RH- (H12-22) - E1 (H1224)
BR - W-B
Headlight beam level
control actuator RH
(Ground circuit)
LH- (H12-23) - E1 (H1224)
LG - W-B
Headlight beam level
control actuator LH
(Ground circuit)
E1 (H12-24) - Body
ground (Body ground)
W-B - Body ground
Ground
(a) Using an oscilloscope, check the waveform 1.
Waveform 1
Waveform 1
GND
Item
Content
Tester Connection
SPDR (H12-12) - GND (H12-24)
Tool Setting
5 V / DIV., 20 msec. / DIV.
Condition
Vehicle is driving at approximately 30
km/h (18 mph)
A005135E24
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
CG SG CANH SIL
CANL
1.
CHECK DLC3
(a) The ECU uses ISO 15765-4 for communication.
The terminal arrangement of the DLC3 complies
with SAE J1962 and matches the ISO 15765-4
format.
BAT
H100769E16
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
SIL (7) - SG (5)
Bus "+" line
During transmission
Pulse generation
CG (4) - Body ground
Chassis ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
SG (5) - Body ground
Signal ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
BAT (16) - Body ground
Battery positive
Always
11 to 14 V
CANH (6) - CANL (14)
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Power switch is OFF*
54 to 67 Ω
CANH (6) - Battery positive
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Power switch is OFF*
1 MΩ or higher
LI–29
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
CANH (6) - CG (4)
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Power switch is OFF*
3 MΩ or higher
CANL (14) - Battery positive
LOW-level CAN bus line
Power switch is OFF*
1 MΩ or higher
CANL (14) - CG (4)
LOW-level CAN bus line
Power switch is OFF*
3 MΩ or higher
NOTICE:
*: Before measuring the resistance, leave the
vehicle as is for at least 1 minute and do not
operate the power switch, any other switches or
the doors.
If the result is not as specified, the DLC3 may have
a malfunction. Repair or replace the harness and
connector.
HINT:
Connect the cable of the intelligent tester (with CAN
VIM) to the DLC3, turn the power switch ON (IG)
and attempt to use the tester. If the display indicates
that a communication error has occurred, there is a
problem wither with the vehicle or with the tester.
• If communication is normal when the tester is
connected to another vehicle, inspect the DLC3
on the original vehicle.
• If communication is still not possible when the
tool is connected to another vehicle, the problem
is probably in the tester itself, so consult the
Service Department listed in the tester's
instruction manual.
Intelligent Tester
CAN VIM
DLC3
A082795E07
DTC CHECK / CLEAR
1.
Intelligent Tester
CAN VIM
DLC3
A082795E07
DTC CHECK
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Read DTCs by following the prompts on the tester
screen.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM)
operator's manual for further details.
LI
LI–30
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
2.
Intelligent Tester
CAN VIM
DLC3
LI
A082795E07
DTC CLEAR
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Erase the DTCs by following the direction on the
tester screen.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM)
operator's manual for further details.
LI–31
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
FAIL-SAFE CHART
1.
HEADLIGHT BEAM LEVEL CONTROL ECU
(a) If the headlight beam level control ECU detects the
following malfunctions, it performs the fail safe
control, blinks the master warning light in the
combination meter, and displays "AUTO LEVELING
WARNING" on the multi-display.
Item
Condition to Transfer
Condition to Return
Warning Indication
Over voltage*1
Detects input voltage of more
than 18.5 V
Detects less than 17.5 V
Appears
Low voltage*1
Detects input voltage of less than
9V
Detects more than 9.3 V
Does not appear
Vehicle height sensor
malfunction*1
When either condition below is
met:
• Detects vehicle height sensor
supply voltage of less than 4
V
• Detects vehicle height signal
malfunction (not within 0.5 V
and 4.5 V)
• Vehicle height sensor power
source supply line is open, or
short to GND
• Vehicle height sensor GND
line is open
Detects normal voltage for 5 sec.
Appears
Microcomputer*1
Detects ECU malfunction
Cancels reset of microcomputer
Appears
Leveling angle calculation
value*2
Calculates values out of the
actuator's operative range
-
Does not appear
2.
LI
HINT:
*1: Stops the actuator operation.
*2: Replaces the minimum or maximum value of the
actuator's operating range with the calculated value.
BODY ECU (CONLIGHT CONTROL)
(a) The body ECU keeps the headlight or taillight on if
there is a malfunction in the light sensor systems
while the headlight is on due to the conlight control
(headlight dimmer switch is in AUTO position).
(b) The body ECU prohibits conlight control if there is a
malfunction in the sensor systems when the
headlight turns off.
LI–32
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST
1.
READ DATA LIST
HINT:
Using the intelligent tester's DATA LIST allows switch,
actuator and other item values to be read without
removing any parts. Reading the DATA LIST early in
troubleshooting is one way to save time.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Read the DATA LIST according to the display on the
tester.
Main body ECU
LI
Item
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
ACC SW
ACC switch signal / ON or OFF
ON: Power switch ON (ACC)
OFF: Power switch OFF
-
IG SW
Ignition switch signal / ON or OFF
ON: Power switch ON (IG)
OFF: Power switch OFF
-
D DOR CTY SW
Driver's door courtesy switch
signal / ON or OFF
ON: Driver's door is open
OFF: Driver's door is closed
-
P DOR CTY SW
Passenger's door courtesy switch
signal / ON or OFF
ON: Passenger's door is open
OFF: Passenger's door is closed
-
Rr DOR CTY SW
Rear door courtesy switch signal /
ON or OFF
ON: Either right or left door is
open
OFF: Both right and left door are
closed
-
P LOCK POS SW
Front passenger door lock
position switch signal / ON or
OFF
ON: Front passenger door lock is
in unlock position
OFF: Front passenger door lock
is in lock position
-
DIMMER SW
Headlight dimmer switch signal /
ON or OFF
ON: Headlight dimmer switch is in
HIGH or FLASH position
OFF: Headlight dimmer switch is
in LOW position
-
HIGH FLASHER SW
Headlight dimmer switch signal /
ON or OFF
ON: Headlight dimmer switch is in
FLASH position
OFF: Headlight dimmer switch is
in except FLASH position
-
F FOG LIGHT
Front fog light switch signal / ON
or OFF
ON: Front fog light switch is in ON
position
OFF: Front fog light switch is in
OFF position
-
AUTO LIGHT SW
Auto light switch signal / ON or
OFF
ON: Light control switch is in
AUTO position
OFF: Light control switch is not in
AUTO position
-
HEAD LIGHT SW
Headlight control switch signal /
ON or OFF
ON: Light control switch is in
HEAD position
OFF: Light control switch is not in
HEAD position
-
TAIL LIGHT SW
Taillight switch signal / ON or OFF
ON: Light control switch is in TAIL
or HEAD position
OFF: Light control switch is not in
TAIL or HEAD position
-
ILLUMINATE RATE
Illuminate rate / ON or OFF
Condition value will be displayed
-
D LOCK POS SW
Driver's door lock position switch
signal / ON or OFF
ON: Driver's door lock is in unlock
position
OFF: Driver's door lock is in lock
position
-
LI–33
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
Item
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
LIGHTING TIME
Lighting time / 7.5s, 15s or 30s
Customized value will be
displayed
-
I/L AUTO OFF
Battery saver / ON or OFF
Customized value will be
displayed
-
I/L ON/ACC OFF
Light the I/L when ACC OFF / ON
or OFF
Customized value will be
displayed
-
I/L ON /UNLK
Interior light ON W/Unlock / ON or
OFF
Customized value will be
displayed
-
SENSITIVITY
Turn on luminous intensity /
DARK1, DARK2, NORMAL,
LIGHT1, LIGHT2
Customized value will be
displayed
-
DISP EX ON SEN
Display extinction luminous
intensity / DARK1, DARK2,
NORMAL, LIGHT1, LIGHT2
Customized value will be
displayed
-
DISP EX OFF SEN
Display extinction release
luminous intensity / DARK1,
DARK2, NORMAL, LIGHT1,
LIGHT2
Customized value will be
displayed
-
DRL FUNCTION*
DRL function / ON or OFF
Customized value will be
displayed
-
2.
HINT:
*: w/ Daytime running light
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST
HINT:
Performing the intelligent tester's ACTIVE TEST allows
relay, VSV, actuator and other items to be operated
without removing any parts. Performing the ACTIVE
TEST early in troubleshooting is one way to save time.
The DATA LIST can be displayed during the ACTIVE
TEST.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Perform the ACTIVE TEST according to the display
on the tester.
Main body ECU
Item
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
HAZARD
Turn hazard light flasher relay ON / OFF
-
F FOG LIGHT
Turn front fog light relay ON / OFF
-
HEAD LIGHT
Turn headlight relay ON / OFF
-
HEAD LIGHT (HI)
Turn headlight dimmer relay (headlight
dimmer switch HIGH position) ON / OFF
-
TAIL LIGHT
Turn taillight relay ON / OFF
-
DRL RELAY
(Test Details)
Turn daytime running light relay ON / OFF
(Vehicle Condition)
Power switch ON (IG), engine is stopped and
light control switch is in OFF
-
DIMMER SIG
Turn dimmer relay ON / OFF
-
ILLUMI OUTPUT
(Test Details)
Turn daytime light and key illumination ON /
OFF
(Vehicle Condition)
Doors are closed
-
LI
LI–34
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
HINT:
If a trouble code is displayed during the DTC check, check
the circuit listed for that code in the table below.
Lighting system
DTC No.
B1244
LI
Detection Item
Light Sensor Circuit Malfunction
Suspected Area
- Automatic light control sensor
- Wire harness
- Main body ECU
See page
LI-31
LI–35
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
DTC
B1244
Light Sensor Circuit Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
This DTC is output when a failure in the light sensor circuit is detected.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1244
When either condition below is met:
• Malfunction in automatic light control
sensor
• Open or short in automatic light control
sensor circuit
•
•
•
Automatic light control sensor
Wire harness
Main body ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
LI
Main Body ECU
Automatic Light Control Sensor
CLTE
CLTE
CLTS
CLTS
CLTB
CLTB
E118453E15
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK BODY ECU
(a) Disconnect the A24 sensor connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
A24
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1 (CLTB) - 3 (CLTE)
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
NG
CLTE
CLTB
I039976E01
OK
Go to step 4
LI–36
2
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SENSOR - ECU)
(a) Disconnect the A24 sensor connector.
(b) Disconnect the B6 ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Automatic Light Control Sensor
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A24-4 (CLTS) - B6-15 (CLTS)
Below 1 Ω
A24
NG
CLTS
LI
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
Main Body ECU
B6
23 4
5 6 7 8 9 10
111213141516
CLTS
I102531E01
OK
3
REPLACE AUTOMATIC LIGHT CONTROL SENSOR
OK:
Returns to normal operation.
NG
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
(MAIN BODY ECU)
OK
END
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SENSOR - BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the A24 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
A24
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
A24-1 (CLTB) - Body
ground
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
NG
CLTB
I039976E03
Go to step 6
LI–37
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
OK
5
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SENSOR - ECU)
(a) Disconnect the A24 sensor connector.
(b) Disconnect the B6 ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Automatic Light Control Sensor
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A24-3 (CLTE) - B6-14 (CLTE)
Below 1 Ω
A24
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
CLTE
Main Body ECU
B6
23 4
5 6 7 8 9 10
111213141516
CLTE
I102531E02
OK
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK (MAIN BODY ECU)
LI
LI–38
6
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SENSOR - ECU)
(a) Disconnect the A24 sensor connector.
(b) Disconnect the B6 ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Automatic Light Control Sensor
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A24-1 (CLTB) - B6-16 (CLTB)
Below 1 Ω
A24
NG
LI
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
CLTB
Main Body ECU
B6
23 4
5 6 7 8 9 10
111213141516
CLTB
I102531E03
OK
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK (MAIN BODY ECU)
LI–39
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
Vehicle Speed Signal Circuit
DESCRIPTION
Headlight beam level control ECU receives the vehicle speed signal from the combination meter.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Combination Meter
Headlight Beam Level Control ECU
LI
SPDR
E115290E25
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Check if the combination meter operation is normal before performing the following procedure.
LI–40
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
1
CHECK HEADLIGHT BEAM LEVEL CONTROL ECU (SPEED VOLTAGE)
(a) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
H12
Tester
Connection
Tool Setting
Condition
Specified
Condition
H12-12 (SPDR) Body ground
5 V / DIV., 2 msec.
/ DIV.
Vehicle is driving
approx. 30 km/h
(19 mph)
0 to 14 V
Pulse generation
(See waveform 1
)
OK:
Waveform is output as shown in the illustration.
SPDR
OK
LI
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
GND
I102532E01
NG
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ECU - METER)
Wire Harness Side
Headlight Beam Level Control ECU
H12
(a) Disconnect the H12 ECU connector.
(b) Disconnect the C10 meter connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
H12-12 (SPDR) - C10-13
Below 1 Ω
H12-12 (SPDR) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
SPDR
Combination Meter
C10
13
I039983E05
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
LI–41
OK
REPLACE COMBINATION METER
LI
LI–42
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
Headlight Relay Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The main body ECU controls H-LP relay and DIM relay when signals are received from the combination
switch.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Main Body ECU
DIM
DRL/DIM
LI
H-LP
HRLY
from Battery
to H-LP LO LH Fuse
to H-LP LO RH Fuse
to H-LP HI LH Fuse
to H-LP HI RH Fuse
I102416E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (HEADLIGHT)
(a) Select the ACTIVE TEST, use the intelligent tester (with
CAN VIM) to generate a control command, and then
check that the headlight illuminates.
Main body ECU
Item
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
HEAD LIGHT
Turn headlight relay ON / OFF
-
HEAD LIGHT (HI)
Turn headlight dimmer relay (headlight
dimmer switch in HIGH position) ON / OFF
-
OK:
Headlight turns on.
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
LI–43
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
NG
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ECU - BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the B7 ECU connector.
(b) Using a service wire, connect B7-20 (HRLY) of the wire
harness side and body ground.
OK:
Headlight (Low beam) turns on.
Wire Harness Side
B7
NG
HRLY
Go to step 4
LI
I102533E01
OK
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ECU - BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the B7 ECU connector.
(b) Using a service wire, connect B7-20 (HRLY) of the wire
harness side and body ground.
(c) Using a service wire, connect B7-2 (DRL/DIM) of the
wire harness side and body ground.
OK:
Headlight (High beam) turns on.
Wire Harness Side
B7
DRL / DIM
NG
HRLY
Go to step 5
I102533E02
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ECU - BATTERY)
(a) Disconnect the B7 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
B7
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
B7-20 (HRLY) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
NG
HRLY
I102533E03
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR (DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION
BLOCK - BATTERY)
LI–44
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (EACH HEADLIGHT (LOW BEAM) CIRCUIT)
5
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ECU - BATTERY)
(a) Disconnect the B7 ECU connector.
(b) Using a service wire, connect B7-20 (HRLY) of the wire
harness side and body ground.
(c) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
B7
LI
DRL / DIM
HRLY
I102533E02
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
B7-2 (DRL/DIM) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR (DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION
BLOCK - ENGINE ROOM RELAY BLOCK
AND JUNCTION BLOCK)
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (EACH HEADLIGHT (HIGH BEAM) CIRCUIT)
LI–45
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
Daytime Running Light Relay Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The main body ECU controls the DRL NO. 4 relay. The DRL NO. 4 relay connects the daytime running
light relay and the headlight during operation. The daytime running light relay controls the illuminance of
the headlight accordingly.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Daytime Running Light Relay
Main Body ECU
PWMI
IG
DRL NO. 4
from H-LP Relay
HON
DRL
+B
ECU-B
from Battery
E
I102415E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Check if the headlight (low beam and high beam) is normal before performing the following procedure.
1
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY)
(a) Select the ACTIVE TEST, use the intelligent tester (with
CAN VIM) to generate a control command, and then
check that the headlight illuminates.
Main body ECU
Item
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
DRL RELAY
(Test Details)
Turn daytime running light relay ON / OFF
(Vehicle Condition)
Power switch ON (IG), engine is stopped and
light control switch is in off
-
LI
LI–46
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
OK:
Headlight (High beam) comes on.
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NG
2
CHECK DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY
(a) Measure the voltage of the relay connector.
Standard voltage
D2
LI
+B
IG
E
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
D2-2 (E) - D2-3 (+B)
Always
10 to 14 V
D2-2 (E) - D2-12 (IG)
Engine is running and
parking brake is
released
NG
Go to step 4
I039977E01
OK
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ECU - BATTERY)
(a) Disconnect the B6 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
B6
23 4
5 6 7 8 9 10
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
B6-12 (HON) - Body
ground
Light control switch in
HEAD
Below 1 V
Light control switch not
in HEAD
10 to 14 V
111213141516
HON
I102534E01
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
LI–47
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY - BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the D2 relay connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
D2
E
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D2-2 (E) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
I039978E01
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
LI
OK
5
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY - BATTERY)
(a) Disconnect the D2 relay connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
D2
Specified Condition
D2-3 (+B) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
NG
+B
I039978E02
OK
Tester Connection
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
LI–48
6
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
CHECK DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK (MAIN BODY ECU)
Driver Side Junction Block (Main Body ECU)
B6
LI
PWMI
I039973E28
(a) Measure the voltage of the connector.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
B6-3 (PWMI) - Body
ground
Light control switch in
HEAD
Below 1 V
Engine is running and
parking brake is
released
10 to 14 V
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY)
LI–49
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
Light Control Switch Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This circuit detects the state of the combination switch.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Main Body ECU
LI
HU
AUTO
TAIL
HEAD
HF
LIB1
Combination Switch
HU
EL
A
T
H
HL
HF
BFG
LFG
OFF
Light
Tail
Control
Switch Head
AUTO
Low
Dimmer
High
Switch
Flash
Fog
Switch
Off
On
I102414E01
LI–50
1
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (COMBINATION SWITCH)
(a) Check the DATA LIST for the proper functioning of the
combination switch.
Main body ECU
LI
Item
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
DIMMER SW
Headlight dimmer switch signal /
ON or OFF
ON: Headlight dimmer switch is in
HIGH or FLASH position
OFF: Headlight dimmer switch is
in LOW position
-
HIGH FLASHER SW
Headlight dimmer switch signal /
ON or OFF
ON: Headlight dimmer switch is in
FLASH position
OFF: Headlight dimmer switch is
in except FLASH position
-
AUTO LIGHT SW
Auto light switch signal / ON or
OFF
ON: Light control switch is in
AUTO position
OFF: Light control switch is in
except AUTO position
-
HEAD LIGHT SW
Headlight control switch signal /
ON or OFF
ON: Light control switch is in
HEAD position
OFF: Light control switch is in
except HEAD position
-
TAIL LIGHT SW
Taillight switch signal / ON or OFF
ON: Light control switch is in TAIL
or HEAD position
OFF: Light control switch is not in
TAIL or HEAD position
-
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION
PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM
SYMPTOMS TABLE
NG
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ECU - BODY GROUND)
Wire Harness Side
Driver Side Junction Block
Main Body ECU
Main Body ECU
B7
B5
1I
HU
LIB1
AUTO
HEAD
TAIL
HF
I102535E01
(a) Disconnect the 1I junction block connector.
(b) Disconnect the B5 and B7 ECU connectors.
LI–51
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1I-4 (HU) - Body ground
Headlight dimmer
switch LOW
10 kΩ or higher
Headlight dimmer
switch HIGH
Below 1 Ω
B5-13 (LIB1) - Body
ground
Fog switch OFF
10 kΩ or higher
Fog switch AUTO
Below 1 Ω
B5-18 (AUTO) - Body
ground
Light control switch
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
Light control switch
AUTO
Below 1 Ω
Light control switch
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
Light control switch
HEAD
Below 1 Ω
Light control switch
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
Light control switch
TAIL
Below 1 Ω
Headlight dimmer
switch LOW
10 kΩ or higher
Headlight dimmer
switch FLASH
Below 1 Ω
B7-3 (HEAD) - Body
ground
B7-21 (TAIL) - Body
ground
B7-22 (HF) - Body
ground
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION
PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM
SYMPTOMS TABLE
NG
3
INSPECT COMBINATION SWITCH
(a) Inspect light control switch.
(1) Measure the resistance of the switch.
Standard resistance
H A T HF HL EL HU
E068152E05
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
12 (EL) - 18 (T)
12 (EL) - 19 (A)
12 (EL) - 20 (H)
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
12 (EL) - 18 (T)
TAIL
Below 1 Ω
12 (EL) - 18 (T)
12 (EL) - 20 (H)
HEAD
12 (EL) - 19 (A)
AUTO
(b) Inspect headlight dimmer switch.
(1) Measure the resistance of the switch.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
11 (HU) - 12 (EL)
12 (EL) - 17 (HF)
FLASH
Below 1 Ω
12 (EL) - 16 (HL)
Low
11 (HU) - 12 (EL)
High
LI
LI–52
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
(c) Inspect fog switch.
(1) Measure the resistance of the switch.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
4 (BFG) - 3 (LFG)
ON
Below 1 Ω
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPLACE COMBINATION SWITCH
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
LI
LI–53
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
Headlight Signal Circuit
DESCRIPTION
Headlight beam level control ECU receives the H-LP relay operation signal from HEAD signal.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Headlight Beam Level Control ECU
H-LP
from Battery
HDLP
LI
to DIM Relay, H-LP LO Fuse
I102413E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
First, check if the headlight operation is normal before performing the following procedure.
1
CHECK HEADLIGHT BEAM LEVEL CONTROL ECU (HDLP VOLTAGE)
(a) Measure the voltage of the connector.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
H12-10 (HDLP) - Body
ground
Light control switch
OFF
10 to 14 V
Light control switch in
HEAD
Below 1 V
HDLP
NG
I102536E01
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR (HEADLIGHT BEAM LEVEL
CONTROL ECU - H-LP RELAY)
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
LI–54
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
Automatic Light Control Sensor Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The main body ECU receives signals from the automatic light control sensor.
HINT:
A DTC is output when the automatic light control sensor is malfunctioning or there is an open or short
circuit in the automatic light control sensor (see page LI-31).
WIRING DIAGRAM
LI
Main Body ECU
Automatic Light Control Sensor
CLTE
CLTE
CLTS
CLTS
CLTB
CLTB
E118453E15
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK BODY ECU
(a) Disconnect the A24 sensor connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
A24
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1 (CLTB) - 3 (CLTE)
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
NG
CLTE
CLTB
I039976E01
OK
Go to step 4
LI–55
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ECU - SENSOR)
(a) Disconnect the A24 sensor connector.
(b) Disconnect the B6 ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Automatic Light Control Sensor
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A24-4 (CLTS) - B6-15 (CLTS)
Below 1 Ω
A24
NG
CLTS
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
LI
Main Body ECU
B6
23 4
5 6 7 8 9 10
111213141516
CLTS
I102531E01
OK
3
REPLACE AUTOMATIC LIGHT CONTROL SENSOR
OK:
Returns to normal operation.
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
OK
END
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SENSOR - BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the A24 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
A24
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
A24-1 (CLTB) - Body
ground
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
NG
CLTB
I039976E03
Go to step 6
LI–56
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
OK
5
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ECU - SENSOR)
(a) Disconnect the A24 sensor connector.
(b) Disconnect the B6 ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Automatic Light Control Sensor
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A24-3 (CLTE) - B6-14 (CLTE)
Below 1 Ω
A24
NG
LI
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
CLTE
Main Body ECU
B6
23 4
5 6 7 8 9 10
111213141516
CLTE
I102531E02
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
LI–57
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
6
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ECU - SENSOR)
(a) Disconnect the A24 sensor connector.
(b) Disconnect the B6 ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Automatic Light Control Sensor
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A24-1 (CLTB) - B6-16 (CLTB)
Below 1 Ω
A24
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
LI
CLTB
Main Body ECU
B6
23 4
5 6 7 8 9 10
111213141516
CLTB
I102531E03
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
LI–58
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
Door Courtesy Switch Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The main body ECU detects the condition of the door courtesy switch.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Main Body ECU
Front Door Courtesy Light Switch LH
DCTY
Front Door Courtesy Light Switch RH
LI
PCTY
Rear Door Courtesy Light Switch LH
RCTY
Rear Door Courtesy Light Switch RH
I102412E02
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
The procedure for each door courtesy switch circuit is the same. First, inspect the suspected door
courtesy switch circuit.
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (DOOR COURTESY LIGHT SWITCH)
(a) Check the DATA LIST for proper functioning of the
transistor relay.
Main body ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
D DOR CTY SW
Driver door courtesy switch signal
/ ON or OFF
ON: Driver's door is open
OFF: Driver's door is closed
-
P DOR CTY SW
Passenger door courtesy switch
signal / ON or OFF
ON: Passenger's door is open
OFF: Passenger's door is closed
-
Rr DOR CTY SW
Rear door courtesy switch signal /
ON or OFF
ON: Either right or left door is
open
OFF: Both the right and left doors
are closed
-
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
LI–59
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
NG
2
CHECK DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK (BODY ECU)
(a) Disconnect the 1D junction block connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
1D
RCTY
DCTY PCTY
Tester Connection
Condition
1D-21 (DCTY) - Body
ground
Driver door is open
Below 1 Ω
Driver door is closed
10 kΩ or higher
1D-24 (PCTY) - Body
ground
Front passenger door is
open
Below 1 Ω
Front passenger door is
closed
10 kΩ or higher
I102537E01
Specified Condition
1D-20 (RCTY) - Body
ground
Rear RH door is open
Below 1 Ω
Rear RH door is closed
10 kΩ or higher
1D-5 (RCTY) - Body
ground
Rear LH door is open
Below 1 Ω
Rear LH door is closed
10 kΩ or higher
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NG
3
INSPECT DOOR COURTESY LIGHT SWITCH
ON
OFF
(a) Remove the courtesy light switch.
(b) Measure the resistance of the switch.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1 - Body ground
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
ON
Below 1 Ω
1
NG
E071371E06
REPLACE DOOR COURTESY LIGHT
SWITCH
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (EACH COURTESY SWITCH CIRCUIT)
LI
LI–60
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
Door LOCK Position Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This circuit detects the state of the door lock detection switch and sends it to the main body ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Main Body ECU
Front Door Unlock Detection Switch LH
LSWD
Front Door Unlock Detection Switch RH
LI
LSWP
Rear Door Unlock Detection Switch LH
LSWR
Rear Door Unlock Detection Switch RH
I102411E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Before this procedure, check if the wireless door lock system operation is normal.
• Each door lock position circuit is the same procedure. First, inspect the suspected door lock position
circuit.
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (DOOR LOCK POSITION SWITCH)
(a) Check the DATA LIST for proper functioning of the
transistor relay.
Main body ECU
Item
Measurement item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
D LOCK POS SW
Driver's door lock position switch
signal / ON or OFF
ON: Driver door lock is in unlock
position
OFF: Driver door lock is in lock
position
-
P LOCK POS SW
Front passenger's door lock
position switch signal / ON or
OFF
ON: Front passenger door lock is
in unlock position
OFF: Front passenger door lock
is in lock position
-
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
LI–61
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
NG
2
CHECK DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK (MAIN BODY ECU)
Driver Side Junction Block (Main Body ECU)
B5
B7
LSWP
LSWR
LSWD
LI
I039973E31
(a) Measure the voltage of the connector.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
B7-25 (LSWD) - Body
ground
Driver side door is
locked
Below 1 V
Driver side door is
unlocked
10 to 14 V
Front passenger door is
locked
Below 1 V
Front passenger door is
unlocked
10 to 14 V
Both rear doors are
locked
Below 1 V
Both rear doors are
unlocked
10 to 14 V
B7-10 (LSWP) - Body
ground
B5-10 (LSWR) - Body
ground
NG
GO TO POWER DOOR LOCK CONTROL
SYSTEM
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
LI–62
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
Taillight Relay Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The main body ECU controls the T-LP relay when a signal is received from the combination switch.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Main Body ECU
T-LP
from Battery
TRLY
LI
PANEL
to Each Illumination
to Glove Box Light
to Front Side Marker Light LH, RH
to Rear Combination Light LH, RH
to License Plate Light LH, RH
TAIL
I102410E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (TAILLIGHT)
(a) Select the ACTIVE TEST, use the intelligent tester (with
CAN VIM) to generate a control command, and then
check that the taillight illuminates.
Main body ECU
Item
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
TAIL LIGHT
Turn taillight relay ON / OFF
-
OK:
Each light comes on.
OK
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
LI–63
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
2
CHECK DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK (MAIN BODY ECU)
Driver Side Junction Block (Main Body ECU)
1E
for Front Side
1D
TRLY
LI
TRLY
1A
TRLY
for Rear Side
1N
1M
TRLY
TRLY
I041126E07
(a) Measure the voltage of the connectors.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1A-15 (TRLY) - Body
ground
Light control switch
OFF
Below 1 V
Light control switch
TAIL
10 to 14 V
LI–64
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1A-33 (TRLY) - Body
ground
Light control switch
OFF
Below 1 V
Light control switch
TAIL
10 to 14 V
Light control switch
OFF
Below 1 V
Light control switch
TAIL
10 to 14 V
Light control switch
OFF
Below 1 V
Light control switch
TAIL
10 to 14 V
Light control switch
OFF
Below 1 V
Light control switch
TAIL
10 to 14 V
Light control switch
OFF
Below 1 V
Light control switch
TAIL
10 to 14 V
Light control switch
OFF
Below 1 V
Light control switch
TAIL
10 to 14 V
Light control switch
OFF
Below 1 V
Light control switch
TAIL
10 to 14 V
Light control switch
OFF
Below 1 V
Light control switch
TAIL
10 to 14 V
1D-10 (TRLY) - Body
ground
1D-29 (TRLY) - Body
ground
1E-10 (TRLY) - Body
ground
LI
1M-6 (TRLY) - Body
ground
1M-8 (TRLY) - Body
ground
1M-9 (TRLY) - Body
ground
1N-7 (TRLY) - Body
ground
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR (EACH TAILLIGHT CIRCUIT)
NG
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ECU - BATTERY)
(a) Disconnect the 1B junction block connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
1B
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1B-1 (TRLY) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
NG
TRLY
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
I102539E01
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
LI–65
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
Headlight Beam Level Control ECU Power Source Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This circuit provides power to operate the headlight beam level control ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Headlight Beam Level Control ECU
LI
IG1
GAUGE
from Battery
IG
from Power Source
Control ECU
E1
I102409E02
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ECU - BATTERY)
(a) Disconnect the H12 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
H12
Tester Connection
H12-1 (IG) - H12-24 (E1)
E1
IG
OK
I039979E04
NG
Condition
Specified Condition
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
Power switch OFF
Below 1 V
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION
PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM
SYMPTOMS TABLE
LI–66
2
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ECU - BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the H12 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
H12
E1
Specified Condition
H12-24 (E1) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
I039979E05
LI
Tester Connection
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR (GROUND CIRCUIT)
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT)
LI–67
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
Height Control Sensor Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The headlight beam level control ECU receives the height control sensor signal from the height control
sensor or height control ECU.
The headlight beam level control ECU calculates a height value from the height control signal. The
voltage at the power source of the height control sensor is corrected when SHR is detected.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Rear Height Control Sensor
Headlight Beam Level Control ECU
SHG
SGR
SHRL
SHR
SHB
SBR
LI
E118453E12
LI–68
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT REAR HEIGHT CONTROL SENSOR
(a) Connect 3 dry cell batteries (1.5 V) in series.
(b) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to terminal
3 (SHB) and negative (-) lead from the battery to terminal
1 (SHG).
(c) Measure the voltage between terminals 1 (SHG) and 2
(SHRL) when slowly moving the link up and down.
Standard voltage
-45°
-2.1 +-6°
0°
LI
Link Angle
Specified Condition
+45° (High)
Approx. 4.5 V
0° (Normal)
Approx. 2.5 V
-45° (Low)
Approx. 0.5 V
+45°
NG
H18
SHG
REPLACE REAR HEIGHT CONTROL
SENSOR
SBH
SHRL
I039980E02
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SENSOR - ECU)
(a) Disconnect the H18 sensor connector.
(b) Disconnect the H12 ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Rear Height Control Sensor
H18
SHG
SHB
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
H12-20 (SGR) - H18-1 (SHG)
Below 1 Ω
H12-5 (SHR) - H18-2 (SHRL)
H12-2 (SBR) - H18-3 (SHB)
H18-1 (SHG) - Body ground
SHRL
H18-2 (SHRL) - Body ground
Headlight Beam Level Control ECU
H18-3 (SHB) - Body ground
NG
H12
SBR
SGR
10 kΩ or higher
SHR
I039981E03
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
LI–69
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
LI
LI–70
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
Headlight Beam Level Control Actuator Circuit
DESCRIPTION
When the actuator receives signals from the headlight beam level control ECU, the step motor is activated
and the angle of the reflector in the headlight will be adjusted.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Headlight Beam Level Control Actuator LH
Headlight Beam Level Control ECU
LI
LH1
LH2
LH3
LH1
LH4
LH3
Headlight Beam Level Control Actuator RH
RH1
RH2
RH3
RH1
RH3
RH3
E118460E04
LI–71
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK HEADLIGHT BEAM LEVEL CONTROL ECU
(a) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
H12
LH3
RH2
LH1
LH2
RH3
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
H12-13 (RH1) - H12-22
(RH3)
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
With power switch ON
(IG) and headlight on,
change the vehicle
height and maintain the
height for more than 2
seconds
10 to 12.6 V
(Approx. 10 seconds)
H12-14 (LH1) - H12-23
(LH3)
RH1
I102536E03
H12-3 (RH2) - H12-22
(RH3)
H12-4 (LH2) - H12-23
(LH3)
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ECU - ACTUATOR)
Wire Harness Side
Headlight Beam Level Control Actuator
H1 *1
H1 *2
H2
LH4*1
RH4*2
LH1*1
RH1*2
LH3*1
RH3*2
Headlight Beam Level Control ECU
(a) Disconnect the H2*1 or H1*1 actuator connector.
HINT:
*1: for LH side
*2: for RH side
(b) Disconnect the H12 ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance:
for LH side
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
H12-4 (LH2) - H2-2 (LH1)
Below 1 Ω
H12-14 (LH1) - H2-3 (LH3)
H12-23 (LH3) - H2-1 (LH4)
H12-4 (LH2) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
H12-14 (LH1) - Body ground
H12
H12-23 (LH3) - Body ground
for RH side
RH3
LH3
RH2
LH2 LH1
RH1
I039982E03
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
H12-3 (RH2) - H1-2 (RH1)
Below 1 Ω
H12-13 (RH1) - H1-3 (RH3)
H12-22 (RH3) - H1-1 (RH4)
H12-3 (RH2) - Body ground
H12-13 (RH1) - Body ground
H12-22 (RH3) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
LI
LI–72
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE HEADLIGHT UNIT (HEADLIGHT BEAM LEVEL CONTROL ACTUATOR)
LI
LI–73
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
Warning Light Circuit
DESCRIPTION
Headlight beam level control ECU sends the warning signal to the combination meter.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Combination Meter
Headlight Beam Level Control ECU
LI
WNG
E115290E19
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Check if the combination meter operation is normal before performing the following procedure.
1
CHECK HEADLIGHT BEAM LEVEL CONTROL ECU
(a) Disconnect the H12 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
H12
WNG
Condition
Specified Condition
H12-11 (WNG) - Body
ground
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
OK
I039979E06
NG
Tester Connection
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION
PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM
SYMPTOMS TABLE
LI–74
2
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ECU - METER)
Wire Harness Side
Headlight Beam Level Control ECU
H12
WNG
(a) Disconnect the H12 ECU connector.
(b) Disconnect the C10 meter connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
H12-11 (WNG) - C10-10
Below 1 Ω
H12-11 (WNG) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
LI
Combination Meter
C10
10
I039983E06
OK
REPLACE COMBINATION METER
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
LI–75
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
Power Source Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This circuit detects the state of the power switch and sends it to the main body ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Main Body ECU
LI
DOME
from Battery
ECUB
IG1
ECU-IG
from Battery
SIG
from Power Source Control ECU
ACC
ACC
ACC
from Power Source
Control ECU
I102408E02
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
Check if the power source control ECU operation is normal before performing the following procedure.
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (POWER SWITCH)
(a) Check the DATA LIST for proper functioning of the power
switch.
Main body ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
ACC SW
ACC switch signal / ON or OFF
ON: Power switch ON (ACC)
OFF: Power switch OFF
-
LI–76
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
Item
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
IG SW
IG switch signal / ON or OFF
ON: Power switch ON (IG)
OFF: Power switch OFF
-
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION
PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM
SYMPTOMS TABLE
NG
2
LI
CHECK DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK (MAIN BODY ECU)
Driver Side Junction Block (Main Body ECU)
1A
1B
ECUB
SIG
I039972E12
(a) Measure the voltage of the connectors.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1A-30 (ECUB) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
1B-1 (SIG) - Body ground
NG
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
LI–77
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
3
CHECK DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK (MAIN BODY ECU)
Driver Side Junction Block (Main Body ECU)
LI
1J
ACC
I039972E13
(a) Measure the voltage of the connector.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1J-5 (ACC) - Body
ground
Power switch ON (ACC)
10 to 14 V
OK
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION
PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM
SYMPTOMS TABLE
LI–78
4
LIGHTING – LIGHTING SYSTEM
CHECK DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK (MAIN BODY ECU)
Driver Side Junction Block (Main Body ECU)
1K
LI
I039973E33
(a) Measure the voltage of the connector.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1K-9 - Body ground
10 to 14 V
NG
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
(MAIN BODY ECU)
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
LIGHTING – HEADLIGHT ASSEMBLY
LI–75
HEADLIGHT ASSEMBLY
BODY ELECTRICAL
LIGHTING
COMPONENTS
LI
HEADLIGHT ASSEMBLY LH
B139853E01
LI–76
LIGHTING – HEADLIGHT ASSEMBLY
Bracket for Repair
LI
FRONT TURN SIGNAL LIGHT BULB
FRONT TURN SIGNAL LIGHT BULB SOCKET
CLEARANCE LIGHT
BULB SOCKET
CLEARANCE LIGHT BULB
NO. 1 HEADLIGHT BULB
HEADLIGHT SOCKET COVER
HEADLIGHT ASSEMBLY LH
B139875E01
LI–77
LIGHTING – HEADLIGHT ASSEMBLY
for HID Headlight
FRONT TURN SIGNAL LIGHT BULB
Bracket for Repair
FRONT TURN SIGNAL LIGHT BULB SOCKET
CLEARANCE LIGHT
BULB SOCKET
CLEARANCE
LIGHT BULB
LI
HEADLIGHT SOCKET COVER
HID HEADLIGHT BULB
HEADLIGHT ASSEMBLY LH
HEADLIGHT LIGHT CONTROL ECU
SUB-ASSEMBLY
GASKET
HEADLIGHT LEVERING
MOTOR ASSEMBLY LH
HEADLIGHT COVER
B139874E01
LI–78
LIGHTING – HEADLIGHT ASSEMBLY
REMOVAL
• Use the same procedures for the RH and LH sides.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
LI
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE FRONT FENDER LINER LH (See page ET-3)
3.
REMOVE FRONT FENDER LINER RH (See page ET-3)
4.
REMOVE FRONT BUMPER COVER (See page ET-4)
5.
REMOVE HEADLIGHT ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the 3 screws.
(b) Pull the headlight towards the front of the vehicle,
disconnect all connectors and remove the headlight.
6.
REMOVE NO. 1 HEADLIGHT BULB (w/o HID
Headlight System)
(a) Turn the headlight socket cover in the direction
indicated by the arrow in the illustration to remove it.
E070529E01
E073676E01
(b) Push the set spring in the direction indicated by the
arrow in the illustration to remove the No. 1
headlight bulb.
NOTICE:
Do not touch the bulb glass with your fingers.
E070537E01
LIGHTING – HEADLIGHT ASSEMBLY
7.
LI–79
REMOVE HID HEADLIGHT BULB (w/ HID Headlight
System)
(a) Turn the headlight socket cover in the direction
indicated by the arrow in the illustration to remove it.
E070532E01
(b) Turn the headlight light control ECU socket in the
direction indicated by the arrow in the illustration to
remove it.
LI
E070533E01
(c) Push the set spring in the direction indicated by the
arrow in the illustration and remove the discharge
headlight bulb.
NOTICE:
Do not touch the bulb glass with your fingers.
E070534E01
8.
REMOVE CLEARANCE LIGHT BULB
(a) Turn the clearance light socket and bulb in the
direction indicated by the arrow in the illustration to
remove them.
9.
REMOVE FRONT TURN SIGNAL LIGHT BULB
(a) Rotate the front turn signal light socket and bulb in
the direction indicated by the arrow in the illustration
to remove them.
E070531E01
E070530E02
LI–80
LIGHTING – HEADLIGHT ASSEMBLY
10. REMOVE HEADLIGHT LIGHT CONTROL ECU SUBASSEMBLY (w/ HID Headlight System)
(a) Remove the 4 screws, headlight cover and gasket.
E070535E01
(b) Remove the 2 screws.
LI
I038408E01
(c) Disengage the claw and disconnect the connector,
and then remove the headlight light control ECU.
HINT:
If the bulb socket cannot be removed due to
interference with the reflector, turn the aiming screw
counterclockwise, move the reflector, and then
remove the bulb socket.
Claw
E074102E01
11. REMOVE HEADLIGHT LEVERING MOTOR
ASSEMBLY LH (w/ HID Headlight System)
(a) Rotate the headlight leveling motor in the direction
indicated by arrow (1) in the illustration.
(b) Rotate the aiming screw on the headlight leveling
motor in the direction indicated by arrow (2) in the
illustration and remove the shaft.
(c) Pull the headlight leveling motor towards you to
remove it.
(2)
(1)
I040081E03
LIGHTING – HEADLIGHT ASSEMBLY
LI–81
ADJUSTMENT
1.
V LH Line
V Line
V RH Line
H Line
Ground
I033423E02
ADJUST HEADLIGHT AIM ONLY
HINT:
• Perform aim adjustment with low-beam.
• Since the low-beam light and the high-beam light are
a unit, if aiming on either side is correct, the other side
should also be correct. However, check both beams
to make sure.
(a) Prepare the vehicle by performing the following.
• Ensure there is no damage or deformation to the
body around the headlights.
• Fill the fuel tank.
• Make sure that the oil is filled to the specified
level.
• Make sure that the coolant is filled to the
specified level.
• Inflate the tires to the appropriate pressure (see
page TW-3).
• Place the spare tire, tools, and jack in their
original position.
• Unload the trunk.
• Sit a person of average weight (68 kg (150 lbs))
in the driver's seat.
(b) Prepare a piece of thick white paper (draw base
lines).
HINT:
• Stand the paper perpendicularly against a wall.
• The base lines differ for "Low-beam inspection"
and "High-beam inspection".
(1) V line (vehicle center position).
Draw a vertical line down the center of the
paper to align with the center of the vehicle.
(2) H line (headlight height).
Draw a horizontal line across the paper so that
it is at the same height as the center mark of
the low-beam light on the vehicle.
(3) V LH line, V RH line (center mark position of
right and left headlights).
Draw vertical lines on the left and right sides of
the paper so that they line up with the center
mark on the low-beam lights on the vehicle.
HINT:
When performing "High-beam inspection",
draw an H line, a V LH line, and a V RH line
based on the center mark on the high-beam
headlight side.
LI
LI–82
LIGHTING – HEADLIGHT ASSEMBLY
V RH Line
90°
3 m (9.84 ft.)
V Line
V LH Line
I038904E02
(c) Check headlight aim
(1) Align the paper and vehicle.
• Make a distance of 3 m (9.84 ft.) between
the headlights and the paper. Place the
paper against a wall with the H line at the
same height as the center mark.
• Align the center of the vehicle with the V line
on the paper. Ensure that the paper forms a
90° angle to the V line.
(2) Start the engine.
(3) Turn on the headlight and check that the aim is
within the specified range shown in the
illustration.
LI
High Beam
V LH Line, V RH Line
40 mm
(1.57 in.)
40 mm
(1.57 in.)
40 mm
(1.57 in.)
40 mm
(1.57 in.)
I037307E02
LIGHTING – HEADLIGHT ASSEMBLY
High Beam
LI–83
V LH Line, V RH Line
40 mm
(1.57 in.)
H Line
40 mm
(1.57 in.)
40 mm 40 mm
(1.57 in.) (1.57 in.) I033426E05
(d) Adjust the aim in the vertical direction:
Using a screwdriver, adjust the headlight aim into
the specified range by turning aiming screw A.
NOTICE:
• Adjust the headlight aim by turning the screw
in the tightening direction.
• When the screw is tightened excessively,
loosen it once and retighten it to adjust the
headlight aim.
HINT:
The headlight aim moves down when turning the
screw clockwise, and moves up when turning the
screw counterclockwise.
Halogen Headlight
(A)
Discharge Headlight
(A)
I038413E03
LI
LI–84
LIGHTING – HEADLIGHT ASSEMBLY
INSTALLATION
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH and LH sides.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
INSTALL HEADLIGHT LEVERING MOTOR
ASSEMBLY LH (w/ HID Headlight System)
(a) Attach the headlight levering motor to the headlight.
(b) Rotate the aiming screw on the headlight leveling
motor in the direction indicated by arrow (2) in the
illustration and install the shaft.
(c) Rotate the headlight leveling motor in the direction
indicated by arrow (3) in the illustration to install it.
2.
INSTALL HEADLIGHT LIGHT CONTROL ECU SUBASSEMBLY (w/ HID Headlight System)
(a) Install the headlight cover and gasket with the 4
screws.
(2)
(3)
(1)
B136392E01
LI
E070535E01
(b) Install the 2 screws.
I038408E01
(c) Attach the claw and disconnect the connector, and
then install the headlight light control ECU.
HINT:
If the bulb socket cannot be removed due to
interference with the reflector, turn the aiming screw
counterclockwise, move the reflector, and then
install the bulb socket.
Claw
B136391E01
LIGHTING – HEADLIGHT ASSEMBLY
LI–85
3.
INSTALL FRONT TURN SIGNAL LIGHT BULB
(a) Rotate the front turn signal light socket and bulb in
the direction indicated by the arrow in the illustration
to install them.
4.
INSTALL CLEARANCE LIGHT BULB
(a) Turn the clearance light socket and bulb in the
direction indicated by the arrow in the illustration to
install them.
B136390
B136389
5.
INSTALL HID HEADLIGHT BULB (w/ HID Headlight
System)
(a) Push the set spring in the direction indicated by the
arrow in the illustration and install the discharge
headlight bulb.
NOTICE:
Do not touch the bulb glass with your fingers.
B136388
(b) Turn the headlight light control ECU socket in the
direction indicated by the arrow in the illustration to
install it.
B136387
(c) Turn the headlight socket cover in the direction
indicated by the arrow in the illustration to install it.
B136386
LI
LI–86
LIGHTING – HEADLIGHT ASSEMBLY
6.
INSTALL NO. 1 HEADLIGHT BULB (w/o HID
Headlight System)
(a) Push the set spring in the direction indicated by the
arrow in the illustration to install the No. 1 headlight
bulb.
NOTICE:
Do not touch the bulb glass with your fingers.
B136385
(b) Turn the headlight socket cover in the direction
indicated by the arrow in the illustration to install it.
LI
B136384
7.
INSTALL HEADLIGHT ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the 3 screws.
(b) Connect all connectors and install the headlight.
8.
INSTALL FRONT BUMPER COVER (See page ET-6)
9.
INSTALL FRONT FENDER LINER RH (See page ET-7)
10. INSTALL FRONT FENDER LINER LH (See page ET-7)
E070529E01
11. CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
12. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
13. ADJUST HEADLIGHT AIM ONLY (See page LI-80)
14. ADJUST FOG LIGHT AIMING (See page LI-87)
LI–86
LIGHTING – FOG LIGHT ASSEMBLY
FOG LIGHT ASSEMBLY
BODY ELECTRICAL
LIGHTING
COMPONENTS
LI
FOG LIGHT UNIT LH
B139854E01
LIGHTING – FOG LIGHT ASSEMBLY
LI–87
REMOVAL
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH and LH sides.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
E074103E02
1.
REMOVE FRONT FENDER LINER LH (See page ET-3)
2.
REMOVE FRONT FENDER LINER RH (See page ET-3)
3.
REMOVE FRONT BUMPER COVER (See page ET-4)
4.
REMOVE RADIATOR GRILLE LOWER LH (See page
ET-5)
5.
REMOVE FOG LIGHT UNIT LH
(a) Detach the 3 claws and push the fog light unit
towards the front of the vehicle.
(b) Remove the fog light bulb from the fog light unit.
LI
LI–88
LIGHTING – FOG LIGHT ASSEMBLY
ADJUSTMENT
1.
LI
ADJUST FOG LIGHT AIM
(a) Prepare the vehicle by performing the following.
• Ensure there is no damage or deformation to the
body around the headlights.
• Fill the fuel tank.
• Make sure that the oil is filled to the specified
level.
• Make sure that the coolant is filled to the
specified level.
• Inflate the tires to the appropriate pressure (see
page TW-3).
• Place the spare tire, tools, and jack in their
original position.
• Unload the trunk.
• Sit a person of average weight (68 kg (150 lbs))
in the driver's seat.
(b) Start the engine and let it idle.
(c) From underneath the vehicle, turn the screw to
perform the adjustment.
HINT:
• The light moves up when turning the screw
clockwise, and moves down when turning the
screw counterclockwise.
• When adjusting the fog light, insert a screwdriver
into the front fender liner fog light service hole.
I038409E01
LIGHTING – FOG LIGHT ASSEMBLY
LI–89
INSTALLATION
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH and LH sides.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
E074103E02
1.
INSTALL FOG LIGHT UNIT LH
(a) Install the fog light bulb to the fog light unit.
(b) Attach the 3 claws to install the light unit.
2.
INSTALL RADIATOR GRILLE LOWER LH (See page
ET-6)
3.
INSTALL FRONT BUMPER COVER (See page ET-6)
4.
INSTALL FRONT FENDER LINER RH (See page ET-7)
5.
INSTALL FRONT FENDER LINER LH (See page ET-7)
6.
ADJUST FOG LIGHT AIMING (See page LI-87)
7.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
8.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
LI
LIGHTING – REAR COMBINATION LIGHT ASSEMBLY
LI–89
REAR COMBINATION LIGHT ASSEMBLY
BODY ELECTRICAL
LIGHTING
COMPONENTS
LI
REAR COMBINATION LIGHT ASSEMBLY LH
B139861E01
LI–90
LIGHTING – REAR COMBINATION LIGHT ASSEMBLY
REMOVAL
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH and LH sides.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
LI
Pin
I039795E01
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE REAR COMBINATION LIGHT SERVICE
COVER LH
3.
REMOVE REAR COMBINATION LIGHT ASSEMBLY
LH
(a) Remove the 2 nuts.
(b) Slide the 2 pins towards the back of the vehicle to
remove them.
(c) Disconnect the connector and remove the rear
combination light.
(d) Remove the 3 bulb sockets and 3 bulbs from the
rear combination light.
LIGHTING – REAR COMBINATION LIGHT ASSEMBLY
LI–91
INSTALLATION
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH and LH sides.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
INSTALL REAR COMBINATION LIGHT ASSEMBLY
LH
(a) Install the 3 bulbs and bulb sockets to the rear
combination light.
(b) Connect the connector and install the rear
combination light.
(c) Slide the 2 pins towards the back of the vehicle to
install them.
(d) Install the 2 nuts.
2.
INSTALL REAR COMBINATION LIGHT SERVICE
COVER LH
3.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
4.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
Pin
I039795E01
LI
LIGHTING – LICENSE PLATE LIGHT ASSEMBLY
LI–91
LICENSE PLATE LIGHT ASSEMBLY
BODY ELECTRICAL
LIGHTING
COMPONENTS
LI
LICENSE PLATE LIGHT ASSEMBLY
B139862E01
LI–92
LIGHTING – LICENSE PLATE LIGHT ASSEMBLY
REMOVAL
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH and LH sides.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
(1)
LI
(2)
E074104E03
1.
REMOVE BACK DOOR TRIM BOARD ASSEMBLY
(See page ED-43)
2.
REMOVE BACK DOOR OUTSIDE GARNISH SUBASSEMBLY (See page ET-37)
3.
REMOVE LICENSE PLATE LIGHT ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the light as shown in the illustration.
(b) Disconnect the connector.
(c) Remove the bulb/socket unit from the light.
(d) Remove the bulb from the socket.
LIGHTING – LICENSE PLATE LIGHT ASSEMBLY
LI–93
INSTALLATION
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH and LH sides.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
INSTALL LICENSE PLATE LIGHT LENS
(a) Install the bulb to the socket.
(b) Install the bulb/socket unit to light.
(c) Connect the connector.
(d) Install the light as shown in the illustration.
(2)
2.
INSTALL BACK DOOR OUTSIDE GARNISH SUBASSEMBLY (See page ET-38)
3.
INSTALL BACK DOOR TRIM BOARD ASSEMBLY
(See page ED-48)
4.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
5.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
(1)
B136393E01
LI
LIGHTING – HIGH MOUNTED STOP LIGHT ASSEMBLY
LI–93
HIGH MOUNTED STOP LIGHT ASSEMBLY
BODY ELECTRICAL
LIGHTING
COMPONENTS
LI
CENTER STOP LIGHT ASSEMBLY
B139863E01
LI–94
LIGHTING – HIGH MOUNTED STOP LIGHT ASSEMBLY
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
Wire Harness Side
1.
H19
E072841E01
LI
CHECK CENTER STOP LIGHT ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the H19 light connector.
(b) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
Brake pedal pressed
Below 1 V
1-2
Brake pedal depressed
10 to 14 V
LIGHTING – HIGH MOUNTED STOP LIGHT ASSEMBLY
LI–95
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE BACK DOOR TRIM UPPER PANEL
ASSEMBLY (See page ED-44)
3.
REMOVE CENTER STOP LIGHT ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Tie a string around the center stop light assembly
cord.
LI
E071103E01
(c) Remove the 2 screws and the center stop light
assembly.
NOTICE:
The string will be used when installing, so leave
the string as it is inside the back door.
E071102E01
LI–96
LIGHTING – HIGH MOUNTED STOP LIGHT ASSEMBLY
INSTALLATION
E071102E01
LI
1.
INSTALL BACK DOOR TRIM UPPER PANEL
ASSEMBLY (See page ED-47)
2.
INSTALL CENTER STOP LIGHT ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the center stop light with 2 screws.
(b) Connect the connector.
3.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
4.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
LI–96
LIGHTING – MAP LIGHT ASSEMBLY
MAP LIGHT ASSEMBLY
BODY ELECTRICAL
LIGHTING
COMPONENTS
MAP LIGHT ASSEMBLY
LI
B139857E01
LI–97
LIGHTING – MAP LIGHT ASSEMBLY
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE MAP LIGHT ASSEMBLY (See page IR-12)
3.
REMOVE MAP LIGHT BULB
(a) Remove the bulb from the map light.
INSPECTION
1.
E072839E03
INSPECT MAP LIGHT ASSEMBLY
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in
the table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1-3
1-4
Switch is OFF
10 kΩ or higher
If the result is not as specified, replace the light
assembly.
(b) Connect the battery positive (+) lead from the
battery to terminal 1 and battery negative (-) lead to
terminal 3, then check that the illumination comes
on when the switch is in the DOOR position.
OK:
Illumination comes on.
If the result is not as specified, replace the light
assembly.
(c) Connect the battery positive (+) lead from the
battery to terminal 1 and battery negative (-) lead to
terminal 4, then check that the illumination comes
on when the switch is in the ON position.
OK:
Illumination comes on.
If the result is not as specified, replace the light
assembly.
LI
LI–98
LIGHTING – MAP LIGHT ASSEMBLY
INSTALLATION
LI
1.
INSTALL MAP LIGHT BULB
(a) Install the bulb to the map light.
2.
INSTALL MAP LIGHT ASSEMBLY (See page IR-15)
3.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
4.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
LI–98
LIGHTING – ROOM LIGHT ASSEMBLY
ROOM LIGHT ASSEMBLY
BODY ELECTRICAL
LIGHTING
COMPONENTS
ROOM NO. 1 LIGHT ASSEMBLY
LI
B139855E01
LI–99
LIGHTING – ROOM LIGHT ASSEMBLY
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE ROOM NO. 1 LIGHT ASSEMBLY (See page
IR-12)
3.
REMOVE ROOM NO. 1 LIGHT BULB
(a) Remove the bulb from the room No. 1 light
assembly.
INSPECTION
1.
I040819E02
INSPECT ROOM NO. 1 LIGHT ASSEMBLY
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in
the table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
1-3
Switch is OFF
10 kΩ or higher
If the result is not as specified, replace the light
assembly.
(b) Connect the battery positive (+) lead from the
battery to terminal 1 and battery negative (-) lead to
terminal 2, then check that the illumination comes
on when the switch is in the DOOR position.
OK:
Illumination comes on.
If the result is not as specified, replace the light
assembly.
(c) Connect the battery positive (+) lead from the
battery to terminal 1 and battery negative (-) lead to
terminal 3, then check that the illumination comes
on when the switch is in the ON position.
OK:
Illumination comes on.
If the result is not as specified, replace the light
assembly.
LI
LI–100
LIGHTING – ROOM LIGHT ASSEMBLY
INSTALLATION
LI
1.
INSTALL ROOM NO. 1 LIGHT BULB
(a) Install the bulb to the room No. 1 light.
2.
INSTALL ROOM NO. 1 LIGHT ASSEMBLY (See page
IR-14)
3.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
4.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
LIGHTING – DOOR COURTESY LIGHT
LI–101
DOOR COURTESY LIGHT
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT FRONT DOOR COURTESY LIGHT
ASSEMBLY
(a) Connect the battery positive (+) lead from the
battery to one of the terminals and battery negative
(-) lead to the other terminal, then check that the
light comes on.
OK:
Light comes on.
If the result is not as specified, replace the light
assembly.
LI
LI–102
LIGHTING – GLOVE BOX LIGHT
GLOVE BOX LIGHT
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
E068686
LI
INSPECT GLOVE BOX LIGHT ASSEMBLY
(a) Connect the positive (+) lead from the battery to
terminal 2 and the negative (-) lead to terminal 1,
then check that the light comes on.
OK:
Light comes on.
If the result is not as specified, replace the light.
LI–103
LIGHTING – VANITY LIGHT
VANITY LIGHT
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT VISOR ASSEMBLY (VANITY LIGHT
SWITCH)
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in
the table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
Switch is OFF
10 kΩ or higher
1-2
Switch is ON
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the visor
assembly.
2.
INSPECT VANITY LIGHT ASSEMBLY
(a) Connect the battery positive (+) lead from the
battery to one of the terminals and battery negative
(-) lead to the other terminal, then check that the
light comes on.
OK:
Light comes on.
If the result is not as specified, replace the light
assembly.
LI
LI–104
LIGHTING – HEADLIGHT DIMMER SWITCH
HEADLIGHT DIMMER SWITCH
BODY ELECTRICAL
LIGHTING
COMPONENTS
LI
HEADLIGHT DIMMER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
B139864E01
LIGHTING – HEADLIGHT DIMMER SWITCH
LI–105
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE NO. 2 STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER
3.
REMOVE NO. 3 STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER
4.
REMOVE STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY (See page RS268)
5.
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL ASSEMBLY (See page
SR-8)
6.
REMOVE STEERING COLUMN COVER (See page
SR-8)
7.
REMOVE SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page
RS-278)
8.
REMOVE WIPER AND WASHER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(See page WW-29)
9.
REMOVE HEADLIGHT DIMMER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connectors.
(b) Remove the band clamp as shown in the illustration.
I038392E01
(c) Detach the claws and remove the headlight dimmer
switch.
E068372E09
LI
LI–106
LIGHTING – HEADLIGHT DIMMER SWITCH
INSPECTION
1.
E068152E14
INSPECT HEADLIGHT DIMMER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Inspect the light control switch.
(1) Measure the resistance according to the
value(s) in the table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
12 - 18
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
12 - 19
12 - 20
LI
12 - 18
TAIL
Below 1 Ω
12 - 18
12 - 20
HEAD
Below 1 Ω
12 - 19
AUTO
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the
switch assembly.
(b) Inspect the headlight dimmer switch.
(1) Measure the resistance according to the
value(s) in the table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
11 - 12
FLASH
Below 1 Ω
12 - 16
LOW BEAM
Below 1 Ω
11 - 12
HIGH BEAM
Below 1 Ω
11 - 17
If the result is not as specified, replace the
switch assembly.
(c) Inspect the turn signal switch.
(1) Measure the resistance according to the
value(s) in the table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
12 - 13
Right turn
Below 1 Ω
12 - 13
Neutral
10 kΩ or higher
Left turn
Below 1 Ω
12 - 15
12 - 15
If the result is not as specified, replace the
switch assembly.
(d) Inspect the fog light switch.
(1) Measure the resistance according to the
value(s) in the table below.
Standard resistance
Tester connection
Condition
Specified condition
3-4
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
3-4
Front fog light switch
ON
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the
switch assembly.
LIGHTING – HEADLIGHT DIMMER SWITCH
LI–107
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL HEADLIGHT DIMMER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Insert the headlight dimmer switch assembly so that
its recessed portion matches that of the steering
column shaft.
E068372E08
(b) Install the headlight dimmer switch with the band
clamp and claw.
(c) Connect the connectors.
2.
INSTALL WIPER AND WASHER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(See page WW-29)
3.
INSTALL SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page
RS-278)
4.
INSTALL STEERING COLUMN COVER (See page SR14)
5.
ADJUST SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page
RS-279)
6.
INSPECT STEERING WHEEL CENTER POINT (See
page SR-15)
7.
INSTALL STEERING WHEEL ASSEMBLY (See page
SR-15)
8.
INSTALL STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY (See page RS269)
9.
INSTALL NO. 3 STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER
I038393E01
10. INSTALL NO. 2 STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER
11. CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
12. INSPECT STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY (See page RS269)
13. CHECK SRS WARNING LIGHT (See page RS-269)
14. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
LI
LI–108
LIGHTING – HAZARD WARNING SWITCH
HAZARD WARNING SWITCH
BODY ELECTRICAL
LIGHTING
COMPONENTS
LI
HAZARD WARNING SIGNAL SWITCH ASSEMBLY
B139866E01
LI–109
LIGHTING – HAZARD WARNING SWITCH
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE HAZARD WARNING SIGNAL SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the switch.
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT HAZARD WARNING SIGNAL SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in
the table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
2-3
Hazard warning switch
ON
Below 1 Ω
2-3
Hazard warning switch
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
E072840E02
If the result is not as specified, replace the switch
assembly.
(b) Connect the battery positive (+) lead from the
battery to terminal 4 and battery negative (-) lead to
terminal 1, then check that the illumination comes
on.
OK:
Illumination comes on.
If the result is not as specified, replace the switch
assembly.
LI
LI–110
LIGHTING – HAZARD WARNING SWITCH
INSTALLATION
LI
1.
INSTALL HAZARD WARNING SIGNAL SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the switch.
2.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
3.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
LI–110
LIGHTING – STOP LIGHT SWITCH
STOP LIGHT SWITCH
BODY ELECTRICAL
LIGHTING
COMPONENTS
LI
STOP LIGHT SWITCH ASSEMBLY
B139865E01
LI–111
LIGHTING – STOP LIGHT SWITCH
REMOVAL
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE STOP LIGHT SWITCH ASSEMBLY (See
page BR-22)
INSPECTION
Pin
2
4
Not
1.
1
3
Pushed
E065594E13
1.
INSPECT STOP LIGHT SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in
the table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
Switch pin not pushed
Below 1 Ω
3-4
Switch pin not pushed
10 kΩ or higher
1-2
Switch pin pushed
10 kΩ or higher
3-4
Switch pin pushed
10 kΩ or higher
If the result is not as specified, replace the switch
assembly.
LI
LI–112
LIGHTING – STOP LIGHT SWITCH
INSTALLATION
LI
1.
INSTALL STOP LIGHT SWITCH ASSEMBLY (See
page BR-24)
2.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
3.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
LI–112
LIGHTING – FRONT DOOR COURTESY SWITCH
FRONT DOOR COURTESY SWITCH
BODY ELECTRICAL
LIGHTING
COMPONENTS
LI
FRONT DOOR COURTESY LIGHT SWITCH ASSEMBLY
B139858E01
LI–113
LIGHTING – FRONT DOOR COURTESY SWITCH
REMOVAL
ON
OFF
1
E071371E06
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR COURTESY LIGHT SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the bolt and switch.
(b) Disconnect the connector.
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT FRONT DOOR COURTESY LIGHT SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in
the table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1 - Body ground
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
1 - Body ground
ON
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the switch
assembly.
LI
LI–114
LIGHTING – FRONT DOOR COURTESY SWITCH
INSTALLATION
LI
1.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR COURTESY LIGHT SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
(a) Connect the connector.
(b) Install the switch with the bolt.
2.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
3.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
LI–114
LIGHTING – REAR DOOR COURTESY SWITCH
REAR DOOR COURTESY SWITCH
BODY ELECTRICAL
LIGHTING
COMPONENTS
LI
REAR DOOR COURTESY LIGHT SWITCH ASSEMBLY
B139859E01
LI–115
LIGHTING – REAR DOOR COURTESY SWITCH
REMOVAL
ON
OFF
1
E071371E06
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE REAR DOOR COURTESY LIGHT SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the bolt and switch.
(b) Disconnect the connector.
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT REAR DOOR COURTESY LIGHT SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in
the table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1 - Body ground
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
1 - Body ground
ON
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the switch
assembly.
LI
LI–116
LIGHTING – REAR DOOR COURTESY SWITCH
INSTALLATION
LI
1.
INSTALL REAR DOOR COURTESY LIGHT SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
(a) Connect the connector.
(b) Install the switch with the bolt.
2.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
3.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
LI–116
LIGHTING – BACK DOOR COURTESY SWITCH
BACK DOOR COURTESY SWITCH
BODY ELECTRICAL
LIGHTING
COMPONENTS
LI
BACK DOOR LOCK ASSEMBLY
B139876E01
LI–117
LIGHTING – BACK DOOR COURTESY SWITCH
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE BACK DOOR LOCK ASSEMBLY (See page
ED-45)
INSPECTION
1.
E054740E03
INSPECT BACK DOOR LOCK ASSEMBLY (BACK
DOOR COURTESY SWITCH)
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in
the table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
Back door is closed
10 kΩ or higher
1-2
Back door is opened
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the back
door lock assembly.
LI
LI–118
LIGHTING – BACK DOOR COURTESY SWITCH
INSTALLATION
LI
1.
INSTALL BACK DOOR LOCK ASSEMBLY (See page
ED-46)
2.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
3.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
LI–118
LIGHTING – HEIGHT CONTROL SENSOR
HEIGHT CONTROL SENSOR
BODY ELECTRICAL
LIGHTING
COMPONENTS
LI
HEIGHT CONTROL SENSOR SUB-ASSEMBLY
B139860E01
LI–119
LIGHTING – HEIGHT CONTROL SENSOR
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE HEIGHT CONTROL SENSOR SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the nut and disconnect the height control
sensor link from the rear axle beam.
(c) Remove the 2 bolts and height control sensor.
LI
E071123E01
INSPECTION
1.
-45°
-2.1 +-6°
0°
+45°
H18
INSPECT HEIGHT CONTROL SENSOR SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Connect 3 dry cell batteries (1.5 V) in a series.
(b) Connect the positive (+) lead from the batteries to
terminal 3 and negative (-) lead to terminal 1.
(c) Measure the voltage between the terminal 1 and 2
when slowly move the link up and down.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
+45° (High)
Approx. 4.5 V
1-2
0° (Normal)
Approx. 2.5 V
1-2
-45° (Low)
Approx. 0.5 V
SHG
If the result is not as specified, replace the sensor
sub-assembly.
SHB
SHRL
I039980E03
INSTALLATION
E071123E01
1.
INSTALL HEIGHT CONTROL SENSOR SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Connect the connector.
(b) Connect the height control sensor link to the rear
axle beam with the nut.
(c) Install the height control sensor with the 2 bolts.
2.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
LI–120
LIGHTING – HEIGHT CONTROL SENSOR
3.
LI
ADJUST HEADLIGHT AIM ONLY (See page LI-80)
LIGHTING – HEADLIGHT LEVELING ECU
LI–121
HEADLIGHT LEVELING ECU
BODY ELECTRICAL
LIGHTING
COMPONENTS
LI
HEADLIGHT LEVELING ECU
B139867E01
LI–122
LIGHTING – HEADLIGHT LEVELING ECU
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-7)
3.
REMOVE ECM (See page ES-469)
4.
REMOVE HEADLIGHT LEVELING ECU
(a) Disconnect the ECU connector.
(b) Remove the bolt and ECU.
LI
I039784E01
INSTALLATION
I039784E01
1.
INSTALL HEADLIGHT LEVELING ECU
(a) Install the ECU with the bolt.
(b) Connect the connector.
2.
INSTALL ECM (See page ES-470)
3.
INSTALL GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR ASSEMBLY
(See page IP-12)
4.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
5.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
LI–123
LIGHTING – TURN SIGNAL FLASHER ASSEMBLY
TURN SIGNAL FLASHER
ASSEMBLY
Instrument Panel Junction Block
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
Turn Signal
Flasher Relay
I040817E02
CHECK TURN SIGNAL FLASHER OPERATION
(a) Power source circuit and ground circuit inspection.
(1) Remove the turn signal flasher relay from the
junction block.
(2) Measure the voltage according to the value(s)
in the table below.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1 - Body ground
Power switch ON
10 to 14 V
4 - Body ground
Always
10 to 14 V
LI
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
(3) Measure the resistance according to the
value(s) in the table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
7 - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
(b) Output operation signal inspection.
(1) Install the turn signal flasher relay to the driver
side panel junction block.
(2) Measure the voltage according to the value(s)
in the table below.
Instrument Panel Junction Block: Front
Side
1L-11
1L-12 1L-13 1L-16
Rear Side:
1L-17
1D-27
1A-31
1D-28
1A-14
I040818E02
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1A-14 - Body ground
Hazard warning switch OFF
Below 1 V
Hazard warning switch ON
Alternating between Below 1 V to 9 V (60
to 120 times per minute)
LI–124
LIGHTING – TURN SIGNAL FLASHER ASSEMBLY
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1A-14 - Body ground
Turn signal switch (left turn) OFF
Below 1 V
Turn signal switch (left turn) ON
Alternating between Below 1 V to 9 V (60
to 120 times per minute)
1A-31 - Body ground
1A-31 - Body ground
1D-27 - Body ground
1D-27 - Body ground
LI
1D-28 - Body ground
1D-28 - Body ground
1L-11 - Body ground
1L-12 - Body ground
1L-13 - Body ground
1L-13 - Body ground
1L-16 - Body ground
1L-16 - Body ground
1L-17 - Body ground
Hazard warning switch OFF
Below 1 V
Hazard warning switch ON
Alternating between Below 1 V to 9 V (60
to 120 times per minute)
Turn signal switch (right turn) OFF
Below 1 V
Turn signal switch (right turn) ON
Alternating between Below 1 V to 9 V (60
to 120 times per minute)
Hazard warning signal OFF
Below 1 V
Hazard warning signal ON
Alternating between Below 1 V to 9 V (60
to 120 times per minute)
Turn signal switch (left turn) OFF
Below 1 V
Turn signal switch (left turn) ON
Alternating between Below 1 V to 9 V (60
to 120 times per minute)
Hazard warning signal OFF
Below 1 V
Hazard warning signal ON
Alternating between Below 1 V to 9 V (60
to 120 times per minute)
Turn signal switch (right turn) OFF
Below 1 V
Turn signal switch (right turn) ON
Alternating between Below 1 V to 9 V (60
to 120 times per minute)
Turn signal switch (left turn) OFF
Below 1 V
Turn signal switch (left turn) ON
Above 9 V
Turn signal switch (right turn) OFF
Below 1 V
Turn signal switch (right turn) ON
Above 9 V
Hazard warning switch OFF
Below 1 V
Hazard warning switch ON
Alternating between Below 1 V to 9 V (60
to 120 times per minute)
Turn signal switch (left turn) OFF
Below 1 V
Turn signal switch (left turn) ON
Alternating between Below 1 V to 9 V (60
to 120 times per minute)
Hazard warning switch OFF
Below 1 V
Hazard warning switch ON
Alternating between Below 1 V to 9 V (60
to 120 times per minute)
Turn signal switch (right turn) OFF
Below 1 V
Turn signal switch (right turn) ON
Alternating between Below 1 V to 9 V (60
to 120 times per minute)
Hazard warning switch OFF
Below 1 V
Hazard warning switch ON
Above 9 V
If the result is not as specified, the relay may
have a malfunction.
LI–125
LIGHTING – HEADLIGHT RELAY
HEADLIGHT RELAY
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
B112776E02
INSPECT HEADLIGHT RELAY (Marking: H-LP)
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in
the table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to
terminals 1 and 2)
If the result is not as specified, replace the relay.
2.
4
1
5
1
5
3
2
3
2
4
INSPECT NO. 2 HEADLIGHT RELAY (Marking: DIM)
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in
the table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-4
Below 1 Ω
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to
terminals 1 and 2)
3-4
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to
terminals 1 and 2)
B083458E01
If the result is not as specified, replace the relay.
LI
LI–126
LIGHTING – DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY
DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
D2
1.
+B
IG
E
I039977E01
CHECK DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY
(a) Measure the voltage according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
D2-2 (E) - D2-3 (+B)
Always
10 to 14 V
D2-2 (E) - D2-12 (G)
Engine is running and
parking brake is
released
If the result is not as specified, replace the relay.
LI
2.
3
5
2
1
1
2
5
3
B060778E14
CHECK DAYTIME RUNNING LIGHT RELAY (Marking:
DRL NO. 4)
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in
the table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to
terminal 1 and 2)
If the result is not as specified, replace the relay.
LI–127
LIGHTING – FOG LIGHT RELAY
FOG LIGHT RELAY
3
5
1
2
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
5
2
1
3
B060778E14
INSPECT FOG LIGHT RELAY (Marking: FR-FOG)
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in
the table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to
terminals 1 and 2)
If the result is not as specified, replace the relay.
LI
1NZ-FXE LUBRICATION – LUBRICATION SYSTEM
LU–1
LUBRICATION SYSTEM
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
CHECK ENGINE OIL LEVEL
(a) Warm up the engine, then stop the engine and wait
for 5 minutes. Check that the engine oil level is
between the low and full marks on the oil level
gauge.
If the engine oil is low, check for oil leaks and add
engine oil up to the full mark.
NOTICE:
Do not add engine oil above the full mark.
2.
CHECK ENGINE OIL QUALITY
(a) Check the oil for deterioration, water intrusion,
discoloring or thinning.
If the oil quality is visibly poor, replace the oil.
Oil grade:
Use API grade SL "Energy-Conserving", or
ILSAC multi grade engine oil.
SAE 5W-30 is the best choice for good fuel
economy and good starting in cold weather.
If SAE 5W-30 is not available, SAE 10W-30 may
be used.
However, it should be replaced with SAE 5W30 at the next oil replacement.
Recommended Viscosity (SAE)
5W-30
°C -29 -18
°F -20 0
-7
20
4
40
16
60
27 38
80 100
A066623E13
3.
Oil Pressure Switch
CHECK OIL PRESSURE
(a) Remove the engine oil pressure switch assembly.
(1) Disconnect the oil pressure switch connector.
(2) Using a 24 mm deep socket wrench, remove
the oil pressure switch.
A092503E02
(b) Install an oil pressure gauge.
(1) Install the adaptor, then install an oil pressure
gauge.
(c) Set the vehicle to inspection mode (see page IN34).
(d) Warm up the engine.
(e) Inspect the oil pressure.
Standard oil pressure
Oil Pressure Gauge
A092504E01
Condition
Specified Condition
Idle
59 kPa (0.6 kgf/cm2, 4.2 psi) or more
2,500 rpm
150 to 550 kPa (1.5 to 5.6 kgf/cm2, 22
to 80 psi)
(f)
Remove the oil pressure gauge.
LU
LU–2
1NZ-FXE LUBRICATION – LUBRICATION SYSTEM
(g) Install the engine oil pressure switch.
(1) Apply adhesive to the threads.
Adhesive:
Toyota Genuine Adhesive 1324, Three
Bond 1324 or Equivalent
(2) Using a 24 mm deep socket wrench, install the
oil pressure switch.
Torque: 15 N*m (153 kgf*cm, 11 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Do not start the engine within 1 hour of
installation.
(3) Connect the oil pressure switch connector.
Adhesive
A050082E12
4.
LU
CHECK FOR ENGINE OIL LEAKS
LU–3
1NZ-FXE LUBRICATION – OIL FILTER
OIL FILTER
1NZ-FXE LUBRICATION
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
LU
GASKET
38 (387, 28)
DRAIN PLUG
17.5 (178, 13)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
OIL FILTER SUB-ASSEMBLY
Non-reusable part
A128663E01
LU–4
1NZ-FXE LUBRICATION – OIL FILTER
REPLACEMENT
CAUTION:
• Prolonged and repeated contact with engine oil will
cause removal of natural oils from the skin, leading to
dryness, irritation and dermatitis. In addition, used
engine oil contains potentially harmful contaminants
which may cause skin cancer.
• Precautions should be taken when replacing engine
oil to minimize the risk of your skin making contact
with used engine oil. Wear protective clothing and
gloves. Wash your skin thoroughly with soap and
water, or use a water-less hand cleaner to remove any
used engine oil. Do not use gasoline, thinners or
solvents.
• For environmental protection, used oil and used oil
filter must be disposed of at designated disposal
sites.
1.
DRAIN ENGINE OIL
(a) Remove the oil filler cap.
(b) Remove the oil drain plug, then drain the oil into a
container.
(c) Clean the oil drain plug and install it with a new
gasket.
Torque: 38 N*m (387 kgf*cm, 28 ft.*lbf)
2.
REMOVE OIL FILTER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Using SST, remove the oil filter.
SST 09228-06501
3.
INSTALL OIL FILTER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Check and clean the oil filter installation surface.
(b) Apply clean engine oil to the gasket of a new oil
filter.
LU
SST
A086909E01
(c) Lightly screw the oil filter into place, and tighten it
until the gasket contacts the seat.
(d) Using SST, retighten it by a 3/4 turn.
SST 09228-06501
Torque: 17.5 N*m (178 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
3/4 Turn
SST
4.
A086910E01
ADD ENGINE OIL
(a) Add new oil.
Standard oil capacity
Item
Specified Condition
Drain and refill with oil filter change
3.7 liters (3.9 US qts, 3.3 Imp. qts)
Drain and refill without oil filter
change
3.4 liters (3.6 US qts, 3.0 Imp. qts)
Dry fill
4.1 liters (4.3 US qts, 3.6 Imp. qts)
(b) Install the oil filler cap.
5.
CHECK ENGINE OIL LEVEL (See page LU-1)
1NZ-FXE LUBRICATION – OIL PUMP
LU–5
OIL PUMP
1NZ-FXE LUBRICATION
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
Clip
x6
RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
Clip
NO. 2 AIR CLEANER INLET
LU
ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
x3
x2
ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
x3 x2
x4
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A116928E01
LU–6
1NZ-FXE LUBRICATION – OIL PUMP
AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
7.0 (71, 62 in.*lbf)
WIRE HARNESS
3.0 (31, 27 in.*lbf)
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
CLAMP
8.5 (87, 75 in.*lbf)
PURGE VSV
x2
BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER
RESERVOIR SUB-ASSEMBLY
BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER
RESERVOIR COVER
LU
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
8.5 (87, 75 in.*lbf)
x3
RESERVOIR BRACKET
WINDSHIELD WASHER
JAR ASSEMBLY
14 (143, 10)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A126700E01
LU–7
1NZ-FXE LUBRICATION – OIL PUMP
FRONT WIPER ARM LH
21 (214, 15)
21 (214, 15)
x2
FRONT WIPER ARM COVER
FRONT WIPER ARM RH
HOOD TO COWL TOP SEAL
CLIP
COWL TOP VENTILATION LOUVER RH
COWL TOP VENTILATION LOUVER LH
LU
CLIP
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
x5
WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR CONNECTOR
WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR
AND LINK ASSEMBLY
x7
ENGINE ROOM NO. 2
RELAY BLOCK
x2
6.4 (65, 57 in.*lbf)
8.4 (86, 74 in.*lbf)
FRONT COWL TOP PANEL OUTER
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A116929E02
LU–8
1NZ-FXE LUBRICATION – OIL PUMP
x4
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
x4
10 (102, 7)
IGNITION COIL
x2
x7
x2
VENTILATION HOSE
NO. 2 VENTILATION HOSE
CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
LU
GASKET
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A116930E01
LU–9
1NZ-FXE LUBRICATION – OIL PUMP
52 (530, 38)
52 (530, 38)
52 (530, 38)
CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL
CONTROL VALVE ASSEMBLY
ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR
SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET
55 (560, 41)
52 (530, 38)
STUD BOLT
CRANKSHAFT
POSITION SENSOR
LU
24 (245, 18)
OIL PUMP
ASSEMBLY
x2
32 (326, 24)
24 (245, 18)
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
STRAIGHT PIN
11 (112, 8)
OIL PUMP OIL SEAL x 11
128 (1305, 95)
O-RING
11 (112, 8)
WATER PUMP ASSEMBLY
CRANKSHAFT PULLEY
11 (112, 8)
DRIVE BELT
15 (153, 11)
x3
GASKET
x2
11 (112, 8)
WATER PUMP PULLEY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
Grease application
A116931E01
LU–10
1NZ-FXE LUBRICATION – OIL PUMP
TIMING CHAIN COVER
(OIL PUMP BODY)
LU
OIL PUMP DRIVEN ROTOR
OIL PUMP DRIVE ROTOR
10 (102, 7.6)
OIL PUMP COVER
x3
OIL PUMP RELIEF VALVE
OIL PUMP RELIEF VALVE SPRING
8.8. (90, 78 in.*lbf)
x2
25 (255, 18)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A116932E01
1NZ-FXE LUBRICATION – OIL PUMP
LU–11
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page HB153)
2.
REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page HB153)
3.
REMOVE REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page HB153)
4.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
5.
REMOVE SERVICE PLUG GRIP (See page HB-154)
6.
REMOVE RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
(See page CO-6)
7.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL RH
8.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
9.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
10. DRAIN ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-6)
11. DRAIN ENGINE OIL (See page LU-4)
12. REMOVE WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR AND LINK
ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the windshield wiper motor and rink
assembly (see page WW-13).
13. REMOVE FRONT COWL TOP PANEL OUTER (See
page FU-12)
14. REMOVE AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY
(a) Loosen the clamp, then disconnect the No. 1 air
cleaner inlet from the air cleaner case.
A086911E01
LU
LU–12
1NZ-FXE LUBRICATION – OIL PUMP
(b) Disconnect the mass air flow meter connector, then
remove the wire harness clamp.
(c) Loosen the clamp, then remove the 2 bolts and air
cleaner assembly.
A087334E01
15. REMOVE NO. 2 AIR CLEANER INLET
(a) Remove the clip and air cleaner inlet.
A087335E01
LU
A087336E01
16. SUSPEND BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER RESERVOIR
SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts.
(c) Separate the claw fitting, then suspend the brake
master cylinder reservoir with a rope.
NOTICE:
Be careful of the angle of the brake master
cylinder reservoir when suspending to prevent
air from coming into the hose.
17. REMOVE RESERVOIR BRACKET
(a) Disconnect the hose from the brake master cylinder
reservoir bracket.
(b) Remove the 3 bolts and wire harness clamp, then
remove the brake master cylinder reservoir bracket.
A087337E01
18. REMOVE WINDSHIELD WASHER JAR ASSEMBLY
(a) Loosen the bolt which holds the headlight RH.
(b) Disconnect the connector and remove the wire
harness clamp.
(c) Remove the bolt and bracket.
A087338E01
1NZ-FXE LUBRICATION – OIL PUMP
LU–13
(d) Remove the nut.
(e) Slightly lift the headlight RH and separate the claw
fitting, then remove the washer jar.
(f) Disconnect the hose from the washer jar.
A087339E01
19. REMOVE CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the fuel injector connector and ignition
coil connector.
(b) Remove the 3 bolts and wire harness clamp, then
disconnect the wire harness.
LU
A087340E01
(c) Remove the brake master cylinder reservoir cover.
A087341E01
(d) Disconnect the ventilation hose and No. 2
ventilation hose.
A087343E01
LU–14
1NZ-FXE LUBRICATION – OIL PUMP
(e) Remove the 4 bolts and 4 ignition coils.
A087344E01
(f)
Remove the 9 bolts and 2 nuts, then remove the
cylinder head cover.
20. REMOVE PURGE VSV (See page EC-23)
21. REMOVE DRIVE BELT (See page EM-6)
22. REMOVE WATER PUMP PULLEY (See page CO-11)
23. REMOVE WATER PUMP ASSEMBLY (See page CO11)
A066472E01
24. REMOVE CRANKSHAFT PULLEY
(a) Using SST, hold the crankshaft pulley and loosen
the crankshaft bolt.
SST 09213-58013 (91111-50845), 09330-00021
NOTICE:
When installing SST, be careful that the bolt
which holds SST does not interfere with the
chain cover.
SST
LU
)
A122104E01
(b) Loosen the crankshaft bolt until the 2 to 3 threads of
the bolt is tightened to the crankshaft.
(c) Using SST, remove the crankshaft pulley.
SST 09950-50013 (09951-05010, 09952-05010,
09953-05020, 09954-05021)
(d) Remove the crankshaft bolt.
SST
)
A122105E01
25. REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR SUBASSEMBLY RH
(a) Place a transmission jack underneath the engine,
then put a wooden block on the jack.
A087348E01
1NZ-FXE LUBRICATION – OIL PUMP
LU–15
(b) Remove the 3 bolts and 4 nuts, then remove the
engine mounting insulator RH.
A087349E01
26. REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING SPACER
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and engine mounting spacer.
A087350E01
27. REMOVE ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and engine mounting bracket.
A087351E01
28. REMOVE CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE
ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the bolt and camshaft timing oil control
valve.
29. REMOVE CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (See
page ES-443)
A087352E01
30. REMOVE OIL PUMP ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 15 bolts and nut.
A066477E01
LU
LU–16
1NZ-FXE LUBRICATION – OIL PUMP
(b) Using an E8 "torx" socket wrench, remove the stud
bolt.
A087353E01
(c) Using a screwdriver with its tip wrapped in tape,
remove the oil pump by prying out between the
cylinder head and cylinder block.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the contact surfaces of
the oil pump assembly, cylinder head and
cylinder block.
A087354E01
(d) Remove the 2 O-rings.
LU
A088881E01
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE OIL PUMP ROTOR SET
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and 3 screws, then remove the
oil pump cover.
B009328E01
(b) Remove the oil pump rotor set from the oil pump
body.
NOTICE:
Keep the 2 removed rotors without changing the
arrangement or turning them over.
A089056E01
1NZ-FXE LUBRICATION – OIL PUMP
2.
LU–17
REMOVE OIL PUMP RELIEF VALVE
(a) Remove the oil pump relief valve plug, then remove
the oil pump relief valve spring and oil pump relief
valve.
A089057E01
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT OIL PUMP RELIEF VALVE
(a) Apply engine oil to the oil pump relief valve. Check
that the valve falls smoothly into the valve hole of
the oil pump body by its own weight.
2.
INSTALL OIL PUMP ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the operation.
(1) Apply engine oil to the drive and driven rotors.
Install the rotors to the oil pump body, then
check that the rotors revolve smoothly.
B009329E01
(b) Inspect the tip clearance.
(1) Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance
between the drive and driven rotor tips.
Standard tip clearance:
0.060 to 0.180 mm (0.0024 to 0.0071 in.)
Maximum tip clearance:
0.28 mm (0.0110 in.)
If the tip clearance is greater than the
maximum, replace the oil pump assembly.
B009331E01
(c) Inspect the body clearance.
(1) Using a feeler gauge, measure the clearance
between the driven rotor and oil pump body.
Standard body clearance:
0.250 to 0.325 mm (0.0098 to 0.0128 in.)
Maximum body clearance:
0.425 mm (0.0167 in.)
If the body clearance is greater than the
maximum, replace the oil pump assembly.
B009332E01
REPLACEMENT
Wooden
Blocks
1.
A092512E02
REPLACE OIL PUMP OIL SEAL
(a) Using a screwdriver with its tip wrapped in tape,
remove the oil seal.
LU
LU–18
1NZ-FXE LUBRICATION – OIL PUMP
(b) Using SST, uniformly tap in a new oil seal until its
surface is flush with the oil pump edge.
SST 09950-60010 (09951-00250, 09951-00380,
09952-06010), 09950-70010 (09951-07100)
NOTICE:
Be careful not to tap the oil seal at an angle.
(c) Apply a light coat of No. 2 multipurpose grease to
the lip of the oil seal.
NOTICE:
Keep the lip free of foreign objects.
SST
)
A118474E01
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL OIL PUMP RELIEF VALVE
(a) Apply engine oil to the oil pump relief valve.
(b) Install the oil pump relief valve and oil pump relief
valve spring to the oil pump cover.
(c) Install the oil pump relief valve plug.
Torque: 25 N*m (255 kgf*cm, 18 ft.*lbf)
2.
INSTALL OIL PUMP ROTOR SET
(a) Apply engine oil to the drive and driven rotors.
(b) Install the rotors to the oil pump body with the marks
facing upward.
LU
A089057E01
B009333E01
(c) Install the oil pump cover with the 2 bolts and 3
screws.
Torque: 8.8 N*m (90 kgf*cm, 78 in.*lbf) for bolt
10 N*m (102 kgf*cm, 7 ft.*lbf) for screw
B009328E01
1NZ-FXE LUBRICATION – OIL PUMP
LU–19
INSTALLATION
1.
A067553E01
INSTALL OIL PUMP ASSEMBLY
(a) Install 2 new O-rings to the 2 locations as shown in
the illustration.
(b) Apply seal packing to the engine body and oil pump
as shown in the illustration below.
Seal packing:
Water pump part: Toyota Genuine Seal
Packing 1282B, Three Bond 1282B or
Equivalent
Other part: Toyota Genuine Seal Packing
Black, Three Bond 1207B or Equivalent
NOTICE:
• Remove pump any oil from the contact
surface.
• Install the oil pump within 3 minutes, and
tighten the bolts within 15 minutes after
applying seal packing.
• Do not expose the seal packing to engine oil
within 2 hours of installation.
LU
LU–20
1NZ-FXE LUBRICATION – OIL PUMP
Seal Packing
Seal Packing
B
B
A
A
C
Seal Packing
C
Seal Packing
(Water Pump Part)
LU
Diameter:
A-A
1.5 to 2.0 mm
(0.059 to 0.078 in.)
2.5 mm
(0.098 in.)
B - B, C - C
(After Assembling)
2.5 mm (0.098 in.) or more
5.0 mm
(0.197 in.)
1.5 mm
(0.059 in.)
2.5 mm
(0.098 in.)
B - B, C - C
Other Part
Seal Diameter:
3.5 to 4.5 mm (0.138 to 0.177 in.)
Diameter:
1.5 to 2.0 mm (0.059 to 0.078 in.)
3.5 to 4.5 mm Water Pump Part
Seal Diameter:
(0.138 to
0.177 in.)
3.5 to 4.5 mm (0.138 to 0.177 in.)
1.0 mm
(0.039 in.)
1.0 mm
(0.039 in.)
1.5 to 2.0 mm (0.059 to 0.078 in.)
A117400E03
(c) Align the drive rotor spline of the oil pump with the
rectangular portion of the crankshaft, then slide the
oil pump into place.
A035284E01
1NZ-FXE LUBRICATION – OIL PUMP
LU–21
(d) Using an E8 "torx" socket wrench, install the stud
bolt.
Torque: 10 N*m (102 kgf*cm, 7.4 ft.*lbf)
A087353E01
D
E
A
A
C
C
(e) Install the oil pump with the 15 bolts and nut as
illustrated.
Torque: 32 N*m (326 kgf*cm, 24 ft.*lbf) for bolt A
11 N*m (112 kgf*cm, 8 ft.*lbf) for bolt B
11 N*m (112 kgf*cm, 8 ft.*lbf) for bolt C
24 N*m (245 kgf*cm, 18 ft.*lbf) for bolt D
24 N*m (245 kgf*cm, 18 ft.*lbf) for bolt E
NOTICE:
• Be careful that the chain does not contact the
seal packing when installing the oil pump.
• Install the engine mounting bracket RH and
water pump within 15 minutes after installing
the oil pump.
C
B
C
A037150E01
A089869E01
2.
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT POSITION SENSOR (See
page ES-443)
3.
INSTALL CAMSHAFT TIMING OIL CONTROL VALVE
ASSEMBLY
(a) Apply a light coat of engine oil to the O-ring.
(b) Install the camshaft timing oil control valve with the
bolt.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (76 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
4.
INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING BRACKET
Torque: 55 N*m (561 kgf*cm, 41 ft.*lbf)
5.
INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING SPACER
Torque: 52 N*m (530 kgf*cm, 38 ft.*lbf)
6.
INSTALL ENGINE MOUNTING INSULATOR SUBASSEMBLY RH
(a) Install the engine mounting insulator with the 3 bolts
and 4 nuts.
Torque: 52 N*m (530 kgf*cm, 38 ft.*lbf)
LU
LU–22
1NZ-FXE LUBRICATION – OIL PUMP
SST
7.
INSTALL CRANKSHAFT PULLEY
(a) Align the hole of the crankshaft pulley with the
straight pin, then install the crankshaft pulley.
(b) Using SST, hold the crankshaft pulley and tighten
the crankshaft bolt.
SST 09213-58013 (91111-50845), 09330-00021
Torque: 128 N*m (1305 kgf*cm, 95 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
When installing SST, be careful that the bolt
which holds SST does not interfere with the
chain cover.
8.
INSTALL WATER PUMP ASSEMBLY (See page CO11)
9.
INSTALL WATER PUMP PULLEY (See page CO-11)
A092652E02
10. INSTALL DRIVE BELT (See page EM-6)
11. INSTALL PURGE VSV (See page EC-24)
LU
Seal Packing
A092514E02
11
9
10
8
5
1
3
7
2
6
4
A035756E01
12. INSTALL CYLINDER HEAD COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Apply seal packing to the 2 locations shown in the
illustration, then install the cylinder head cover.
Seal packing:
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three
Bond 1207B or Equivalent
NOTICE:
• Remove any oil from the contact surface.
• Install the cylinder head cover within 3
minutes after applying seal packing.
• Do not start the engine within 2 hours of
installing.
(b) Install the cylinder head cover with the 9 bolts and 2
nuts.
(c) Using several steps, tighten the bolts and nuts with
the specified torque in the sequence shown in the
illustration.
Torque: 10 N*m (102 kgf*cm, 7 ft.*lbf)
(d) Install the ignition coil with the bolt.
Torque: 9.0 N*m (92 kgf*cm, 80 in.*lbf)
(e) Install the brake master cylinder reservoir cover to
the cylinder head cover.
(f) Install the wire harness and brake master cylinder
reservoir cover with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 9.0 N*m (92 kgf*cm, 80 in.*lbf)
(g) Connect the fuel injector connector and ignition coil
connector.
1NZ-FXE LUBRICATION – OIL PUMP
LU–23
13. INSTALL WINDSHIELD WASHER JAR ASSEMBLY
Torque: 4.9 N*m (50 kgf*cm, 43 in.*lbf) for bolt A
14 N*m (143 kgf*cm, 10 ft.*lbf) for bolt B
5.5 N*m (56 kgf*cm, 49 in.*lbf) for nut
A
14. INSTALL RESERVOIR BRACKET
Torque: 8.5 N*m (87 kgf*cm, 75 in.*lbf)
B
A092653E01
15. INSTALL BRAKE MASTER CYLINDER RESERVOIR
SUB-ASSEMBLY
Torque: 8.5 N*m (87 kgf*cm, 75 in.*lbf)
16. INSTALL NO. 2 AIR CLEANER INLET
17. INSTALL AIR CLEANER ASSEMBLY (See page EC29)
18. INSTALL FRONT COWL TOP PANEL OUTER (See
page FU-19)
19. INSTALL WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR AND LINK
ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the windshield wiper motor and wiper link
assembly (see page WW-15).
20. ADD ENGINE OIL (See page LU-4)
21. INSTALL SERVICE PLUG GRIP (See page HB-154)
22. CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL (See page CH-7)
23. INSTALL REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
24. INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-8)
25. INSTALL REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
26. ADD ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-7)
27. CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKS (See page
CO-9)
28. CHECK FOR ENGINE OIL LEAKS
29. INSTALL RADIATOR SUPPORT OPENING COVER
30. INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
31. INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
32. INSTALL FRONT WHEEL RH
Torque: 103 N*m (1050 kgf*cm, 76 ft.*lbf)
33. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
LU
MAINTENANCE – OUTSIDE VEHICLE
MA–1
OUTSIDE VEHICLE
GENERAL MAINTENANCE
Performing the following maintenance checks on the vehicle
is the owner's responsibility. The owner may perform the
maintenance or take the vehicle to a service center. Check
the parts of the vehicle described below on a daily basis. In
most cases, special tools are not required. It is recommended
that the owner perform these checks. The procedures for
general maintenance are as follows.
1.
GENERAL NOTES
• Maintenance requirements vary depending on the
country.
• Check the maintenance schedule in the owner's
manual supplement.
• Following the maintenance schedule is mandatory.
• Determine the appropriate time to service the vehicle
using either miles driven or months elapsed,
whichever reaches the specification first.
• Maintain similar intervals between periodic
maintenance, unless otherwise noted.
• Failing to check each vehicle part could lead to poor
engine performance and increase exhaust emissions.
2.
TIRES
(a) Check the tire inflation pressure with a gauge. Make
adjustments if necessary.
(b) Check the surfaces of the tires for cuts, damage or
excessive wear.
3.
WHEEL NUTS
(a) Check for nuts that are loose or missing. Tighten
them if necessary.
4.
TIRE ROTATION (See page TW-4)
5.
WINDSHIELD WIPER BLADES
(a) Check the blades for wear or cracks whenever they
are unable to wipe the windshield clean. Replace
them if necessary.
6.
FLUID LEAKS
(a) Check under the vehicle for leaking fuel, oil, water
and other fluids.
NOTICE:
If you smell gasoline fumes or notice any leaks,
locate the cause and correct it.
7.
DOORS AND ENGINE HOOD
(a) Check that all of the doors and the hood operate
smoothly and that all the latches lock securely.
(b) When the primary latch is released, check that the
engine hood secondary latch prevents the hood
from opening.
MA
MA–2
MAINTENANCE – INSIDE VEHICLE
INSIDE VEHICLE
GENERAL MAINTENANCE
Performing the following maintenance checks on the vehicle
is the owner's responsibility. The owner may perform the
maintenance or take the vehicle to a service center. Check
the parts of the vehicle described below on a daily basis. In
most cases, special tools are not required. It is recommended
that the owner perform these checks. The procedures for
general maintenance are as follows.
MA
1.
GENERAL NOTES
• Maintenance requirements vary depending on the
country.
• Check the maintenance schedule in the owner's
manual supplement.
• Following the maintenance schedule is mandatory.
• Determine the appropriate time to service the vehicle
using either miles driven or months elapsed,
whichever reaches the specification first.
• Maintain similar intervals between periodic
maintenance, unless otherwise noted.
• Failing to check each vehicle part could lead to poor
engine performance and increase exhaust emissions.
2.
LIGHTS
(a) Check that the headlights, stop lights, taillights, turn
signal lights, and other lights illuminate or blink
properly. Also, check if they have enough
brightness.
(b) Check that the headlights are aimed properly.
3.
WARNING LIGHTS AND BUZZERS
(a) Check that all the warning lights and buzzers are
working.
4.
HORNS
(a) Check that the horn is working.
5.
WINDSHIELD GLASS
(a) Check for scratches, pits or abrasions.
6.
WINDSHIELD WIPERS AND WASHER
(a) Check that the windshield washers are aimed
properly. Also, check that the center stream of
washer fluid sprays on the windshield within the
operating range of the wipers.
(b) Check if the wipers streak or not.
7.
WINDSHIELD DEFROSTER
(a) When the heater or air conditioning is on the
defroster setting, check if air comes out of the
defroster outlet.
8.
REAR VIEW MIRROR
(a) Check that the rear view mirror is securely mounted.
MAINTENANCE – INSIDE VEHICLE
9.
MA–3
SUN VISORS
(a) Check that the sun visors move freely and are
securely mounted.
10. STEERING WHEEL
(a) Check that the steering wheel has the proper
amount of free play. Also check for steering difficulty
and unusual noises.
11. SEATS
(a) Check that the seat adjusters, seatback recliner and
other front seat controls operate smoothly.
(b) Check that all the latches lock securely in all
positions.
(c) Check that the locks hold securely in all latched
positions.
(d) Check that the headrests move up and down
smoothly and that the locks hold securely in all
latched positions.
(e) When the rear seatbacks are folded down, check
that the latches lock securely.
12. SEAT BELTS
(a) Check that the seat belt system such as the
buckles, retractors and anchors operate properly
and smoothly.
(b) Check that the belt webbing is not cut, frayed, worn
or damaged. Replace if necessary.
13. ACCELERATOR PEDAL
(a) Check that the accelerator pedal operates smoothly.
In other words, check that the pedal does not have
uneven pedal resistance or become stuck in certain
positions.
14. BRAKE PEDAL
(a) Check that the brake pedal operates smoothly.
(b) Check that the pedal has the proper reserve
distance and free play.
(c) Start the engine and check the brake booster
function.
15. BRAKES
(a) In a safe place, check that the vehicle remains
straight when applying the brakes.
16. PARKING BRAKE
(a) Check that the parking brake pedal has the proper
amount of travel (see page PB-11).
(b) On a safe incline, check that the vehicle is held
securely with only the parking brake applied.
17. HYBRID TRANSAXLE "PARK" MECHANISM
(a) Check the selector lever for proper and smooth
operation.
(b) When the selector lever is in the P position and all
brakes are released on a low incline, check that the
vehicle is stable.
MA
MA–4
MAINTENANCE – UNDER HOOD
UNDER HOOD
GENERAL MAINTENANCE
1.
GENERAL NOTES
• Maintenance requirements vary depending on the
country.
• Check the maintenance schedule in the owner's
manual supplement.
• Following the maintenance schedule is mandatory.
• Determine the appropriate time to service the vehicle
using either miles driven or time elapsed, whichever
reaches the specification first.
• Maintain similar intervals between periodic
maintenance, unless otherwise noted.
• Failing to check each vehicle part could lead to poor
engine performance and increase exhaust emissions.
2.
WINDSHIELD WASHER FLUID
(a) Check that there is sufficient fluid in the tank.
3.
ENGINE COOLANT LEVEL
(a) Check that the coolant level is between the "FULL"
and "LOW" lines on the see-through reservoir.
4.
RADIATOR AND HOSES
(a) Check that the front of the radiator is clean and not
blocked by leaves, dirt or bugs.
(b) Check the hoses for cracks, kinks, rot or loose
connections.
5.
BATTERY ELECTROLYTE LEVEL
(a) Check that the electrolyte level of all the battery
cells is between the upper and lower level lines on
the case.
HINT:
If the electrolyte level is difficult to see, lightly shake
the vehicle.
6.
BRAKE FLUID LEVEL
(a) Check that the brake fluid levels are near the upper
level lines on the see-through reservoirs.
7.
ENGINE DRIVE BELT
(a) Check the drive belt for fraying, cracks, wear or
oiliness.
8.
ENGINE OIL LEVEL
(a) Check the level on the dipstick with the engine
stopped.
9.
HYBRID TRANSAXLE FLUID LEVEL (See page HX-1)
MA
10. EXHAUST SYSTEM
(a) Check for unusual exhaust sounds or abnormal
exhaust fumes. Inspect the cause and repair it.
MAINTENANCE – ENGINE
MA–5
ENGINE
GENERAL MAINTENANCE
1.
INSPECT DRIVE BELT (See page EM-5)
2.
REPLACE SPARK PLUGS
(a) Replace the spark plugs (see page IG-5).
3.
REPLACE AIR CLEANER FILTER
(a) Remove the air filter.
(b) Visually check that the air filter is not excessively
damaged or oily.
(c) Replace the air filter with a new one, if necessary.
4.
REPLACE ENGINE OIL AND OIL FILTER (See page
LU-1)
5.
REPLACE ENGINE COOLANT (See page CO-2)
6.
INSPECT GASKET IN FUEL TANK CAP (See page
EC-5)
7.
INSPECT FUEL LINES AND CONNECTIONS, FUEL
TANK VAPOR VENT SYSTEM HOSES
(a) Visually check the fuel lines for cracks, leakage,
loose connections and deformation.
8.
INSPECT EXHAUST PIPES AND MOUNTINGS
(a) Visually check the pipes, hangers and connections
for severe corrosion, leaks or damage.
9.
INSPECT VALVE CLEARANCE (See page EM-7)
MA
MA–6
MAINTENANCE – BRAKE
BRAKE
GENERAL MAINTENANCE
1.
INSPECT BRAKE LINES AND HOSES
HINT:
Work in a well-lighted area. Turn the front wheels fully to
the right or left before beginning the inspection.
(a) Using a mirror, check the entire circumference and
length of the brake lines and hoses for:
• Damage
• Wear
• Deformation
• Cracks
• Corrosion
• Leaks
• Bends
• Twists
(b) Check all the clamps for tightness and the
connections for leakage.
(c) Check that the hoses and lines are not near sharp
edges, moving parts or the exhaust system.
(d) Check that the lines are installed properly and pass
through the center of the grommets.
2.
INSPECT FRONT BRAKE
(a) Check the front brake pads and discs (see page BR42).
3.
INSPECT REAR BRAKE LININGS AND DRUMS
(a) Check the brake linings and drums. Also check the
brake linings of parking brake (see page BR-49).
P009958E01
MA
MAINTENANCE – CHASSIS
MA–7
CHASSIS
GENERAL MAINTENANCE
1.
INSPECT STEERING LINKAGE AND GEAR HOUSING
(a) Check the steering wheel free play (see page PS-5).
(b) Check the steering linkage for looseness or
damage.
(1) Check that the tie rod ends do not have
excessive play.
(2) Check that the dust seals and boots are not
damaged.
(3) Check that the boot clamps are not loose.
(4) Check that the steering gear housing is not
damaged.
(5) Check that the connectors are properly
connected to the steering gear housing.
2.
INSPECT BALL JOINTS AND DUST COVERS
(a) Inspect the ball joints for excessive looseness.
(1) Jack up the front of the vehicle and place
wooden blocks with a height of 180 to 200 mm
(7.09 to 7.87 in.) under the front tires.
(2) Lower the vehicle until the front coil spring has
about half its ordinary load. Place stands under
the vehicle for safety.
(3) Check that the front wheels are pointing
straight ahead. Use wheel chocks on all 4
wheels.
(4) Using a lever, pry up the end of the lower arm.
Check the amount of play.
Maximum ball joint vertical play:
0 mm (0 in.)
If there is any play, replace the ball joint.
(b) Check the dust cover for damage.
3.
INSPECT DRIVE SHAFT BOOTS
(a) Check the drive shaft boots for loose clamps,
grease leakage, kinks or damage.
4.
INSPECT HYBRID TRANSAXLE FLUID LEVEL (See
page HX-1)
5.
ROTATE TIRES (See page TW-4)
MA
MA–8
MAINTENANCE – BODY
BODY
GENERAL MAINTENANCE
1.
TIGHTEN BOLTS AND NUTS
(a) Tighten the bolts and nuts on the chassis parts listed
below, if necessary.
• Front axle and suspension
• Drive train
• Rear axle and suspension
• Brake system
• Engine mounting
• Other chassis parts
(b) Tighten the bolts and nuts on the body parts listed
below, if necessary.
• Seat belt system
• Seats
• Doors and hood
• Body mountings
• Fuel tank
• Exhaust pipe system
• Other body parts
2.
CLEAN AIR CONDITIONING FILTER
(a) Visually inspect the surface of the filter (see page
AC-162).
(b) If the filter is contaminated with foreign matter, clean
or replace the filter.
MA
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
ME–1
METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
1.
Cable
Negative (-)
Battery Terminal
D033496E01
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION OF BATTERY
TERMINAL CABLE
(a) Before performing electronic work, disconnect the
battery negative (-) terminal cable in order to
prevent it from shorting and burning out.
(b) When disconnecting and reconnecting the battery
cable, turn the power switch OFF and headlight
dimmer switch OFF. Then loosen the terminal nut
completely. Be careful not to damage the cable or
terminal.
(c) When the battery terminal cable is removed, the
memories of the clock, radio, DTCs, etc. are erased.
So before removing it, check and make a note of
them.
NOTICE:
When disconnecting the cable from the negative
(-) battery terminal, initialize the following
system(s) after the cable is reconnected.
System Name
See procedure
Power Window Control System
IN-32
2.
FOR HYBRID SYSTEM ACTIVATION
(a) When the warning light is illuminated or the battery
has been disconnected and reconnected, pressing
the power switch may not start the system on the
first try. If so, press the power switch again.
(b) With the power switch's power mode changed to
ON (IG), disconnect the battery. If the key is not in
the key slot during reconnection, DTC B2799 may
be output.
ME
ME–2
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
FRONT DOOR COURTESY LIGHT SWITCH LH
ME
FUEL TANK
- FUEL SENDER GAUGE
- FUEL TEMPERATURE SENSOR
AMBIENT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
ENGINE ROOM RELAY BLOCK AND JUNCTION BLOCK
- AM2 FUSE
- RELAY INTEG FUSE
- DC/DC CONV FUSE
- DOME FUSE
- IG2 RELAY
- BACK-UP LIGHT RELAY
B140396E01
ME–3
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
MULTI-DISPLAY
TURN SIGNAL SWITCH
POWER STEERING ECU
ODO / TRIP / RESET SWITCH
PASSENGER SEAT BELT WARNING LIGHT
CERTIFICATION ECU
POWER SOURCE
CONTROL ECU
KM/H OR MPH SELECT SWITCH
GATEWAY ECU
COMBINATION METER
- INDICATOR SENSOR
HV CONTROL ECU
HEADLIGHT BEAM
LEVEL CONTROL ECU
ME
ECM
LIGHT CONTROL RHEOSTAT
DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
- BODY ECU
- GAUGE FUSE
- AM1 FUSE
- IGN FUSE
- IG1 FUSE
OCCUPANT DETECTION
SENSOR
FRONT SEAT INNER BELT RH
FRONT SEAT INNER BELT LH
TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU
SKID CONTROL ECU
TRANSPONDER KEY ECU
CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
AIR CONDITIONING ECU
B140395E01
ME–4
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
ME
ENGINE COOLANT TEMPERATURE SENSOR
B140397E01
ME–5
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
ECM
Fuel Sender Gauge
MIL Signal
Fuel Temp. Sensor
Skid Control ECU
Vehicle Speed Signal
Light Control Rheostat
Headlight Beam Level Control ECU
ODO / TRIP / RESET Switch
Automatic Headlight Leveling
Warning Light Signal
km/h or mph Select Switch
Center Airbag Sensor
Turn Signal Switch
Warning Light Signal
Combination Meter
(Meter ECU)
Passenger Seat Belt Warning Light
Occupant Detection ECU
Back-up Light Relay
Front Seat Inner Belt LH
Occupant Detection Sensor
Front Seat Inner Belt RH
Indicator Sensor
BEAN
I102673E01
ME
ME–6
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
BEAN
Air Conditioning ECU
AVC-LAN
Multi-display
Gateway ECU
Body ECU
CAN
HV Control ECU
ME
Front Door Courtesy Light Switch LH
Skid Control ECU
Certification ECU
Power Steering ECU
Transmission Control ECU
ECM
Transponder Key ECU
Engine Coolant
Temperature Sensor
I102242E01
Gateway
ECU
Signals from/to Combination Meter (Meter ECU)
Gateway ECU
•
Receives ODO METER information signal
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
ME–7
BEAN
ECU
Signals from / to Combination Meter (Meter ECU)
A/C ECU
•
•
•
Body ECU
•
•
•
Transmits ambient temperature signal (for low ambient
temperature warning light)
Transmits indicator light (A/C AUTO, RECIRCULATE, Front DEF,
Rear DEF) ON demand signal
Receives vehicle speed signal
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Receives vehicle speed signal
Receives taillight cancel signal
Transmits D seat door courtesy SW signal (for headlight reminder
control)
Transmits ACC switch signal
Transmits D seat door courtesy SW signal
Transmits warning ON signal (HEAD and TAIL)
Transmits headlight ON signal (HI-BEAM)
Transmits front fog light ON signal (FOG indicator light)
Transmits meter illumination light dimmer demand signal
Transmits warning ON signal (all door courtesy switch)
Certification ECU
•
•
•
Receives vehicle speed signal
Transmits inside cabin key detection signal (Smart Key System)
Transmits buzzer sounding demand signal
Transmission Control ECU
•
•
•
Transmits P state signal
Transmits master warning light (P control malfunction) ON
demand signal
Transmits shift position (N, P) signal
Transponder Key ECU
•
•
•
Transmits master warning light (shift warning) ON demand signal
Transmits buzzer sounding demand signal
Receives vehicle speed signal
Steering Lock ECU
•
•
Transmits buzzer sounding demand signal
Transmits meter display signal
CAN
ECU
Signals from / to Combination Meter (Meter ECU)
HV control ECU
•
•
•
•
•
•
ECM
•
•
•
•
•
•
Skid Control ECU
•
Receives fuel tank level signal
Transmits engine coolant temperature signal (for master warning
light [engine coolant temperature warning])
Transmits engine speed signal (for trip information operation)
Transmits fuel injection volume signal (for trip information
operation)
Transmits test mode signal
Transmits master warning light (OIL. P) ON signal
•
Transmits warning signal (ABS, VSC, BRAKE, ECB) ON/blink
demand signal
Transmits diagnosis signal (ABS, VSC, ECB) ON/blink demand
signal
Transmits SLIP indicator light ON/blink demand signal
•
Transmits EPS warning light ON/blink demand signal
•
Power Steering ECU
Transmits shift position signal (P, R, N, D, B) (for shift position
indicator light)
Transmits cruise indicator light ON demand signal
Transmits master warning light (HV system, main battery, NDB
warning, Motor inverter, CHARGE) ON demand signal
Transmits READY indicator ON/blink & buzzer sounding signal
Transmits starter ON signal
Transmits EV indicator ON/blink and buzzer sounding signal
AVC-LAN
ECU
Signals from / to Combination Meter (Meter ECU)
Multi-display
•
•
•
•
•
Transmits trip information operation signal
Receives warning (fuel level, headlight leveling, EPS) display
signal
Receives trip information display signal
Receives km/h (mph) selector switch signal
Receives taillight cancel switch signal
ME
ME–8
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
METER GAUGE AND WARNING/INDICATOR
Gauge
Item
Signal Description
Speedometer
Based on a signal received from wheel speed sensor, skid control
ECU calculates vehicle speed and transmits data to meter
Fuel
Displays a fuel level receiving a signal from fuel sender gauge (Direct
line)
Warning / Indicator
Item
ME
Signal Description
TURN
Turn signal switch is ON
BEAM
Displays receiving a signal from body ECU (Direct line)
CHARGE
Receives malfunction signal from alternator
MIL
Receives malfunction signal from ECM
DOOR
Open door indicator turns on receiving a signal from body ECU (Direct
line)
SEAT BELT
Driver's seat belt buckle switch is OFF (Unfastened)
BRAKE
Displays when parking brake switch is ON or brake fluid level warning
switch is ON
MAINT REQUID (Blinks)
Blinks when running 4,500 miles after ODO/TRIP switch is set
MAINT REQUID (Comes on)
Turns on when running 5,000 miles after ODO/TRIP switch is set
CRUISE
Receives malfunction signal from ECM
AIRBAG
Receives malfunction signal from airbag ECU
FUEL
Receives fuel empty signal from fuel sender gauge
A/T P
Receives P signal from hybrid vehicle control ECU (BEAN)
A/T R
Receives R signal from hybrid vehicle control ECU (BEAN)
A/T N
Receives N signal from hybrid vehicle control ECU (BEAN)
A/T D
Receives D signal from hybrid vehicle control ECU (BEAN)
A/T B
Receives B signal from hybrid vehicle control ECU (BEAN)
SLIP
Receives malfunction signal from skid control ECU
VSC
Receives malfunction signal from skid control ECU
ABS
Receives malfunction signal from skid control ECU
ECB
Receives malfunction signal from skid control ECU
LOW AMBIENT TEMP
Receives LOW AMBIENT TEMP. signal from A/C ECU (BEAN)
A/C AUTO
Receives A/C AUTO signal from A/C ECU (BEAN)
RECIRCULATE
Receives RECIRCULATE signal from A/C ECU (BEAN)
Rr DEF
Receives Rr DEF signal from A/C ECU (BEAN)
Fr DEF
Receives Fr DEF signal from A/C ECU (BEAN)
SECURITY
Receives SECURITY signal from body ECU (BEAN)
SMART
Receives SMART signal from certification ECU (BEAN)
2.
GENERAL
• The combination meter is digital display type.
• The meter ECU maintains communication with other
ECUs through the BEAN. It also maintains
communication with the ECUs (or components) that
compose the CAN and AVC-LAN through the
gateway ECU.
• The meter ECU and buzzer are installed in the
combination meter.
• The "READY" light comes on to inform the driver that
the vehicle is ready to be driven.
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
3.
4.
ME–9
• The low ambient temperature indicator light comes on
to inform the driver that the ambient temperature is
low (below 3°C (6.6°F)).
• The master warning light comes on with buzzer
sounding if there is a malfunction in each system (see
page ME-11).
• The 2 inclination sensors are built in the combination
meter to detect the inclination (longitudinal and
latitudinal) of the vehicle.
OIL REPLACEMENT REMINDER WARNING LIGHT
(w/ REMINDER WARNING LIGHT)
• 4,500 miles after ODO/TRIP switch is set, the
maintenance indicator begins to blink for 15 seconds
after the power switch is turned ON (ACC or IG).
• 5,000 miles after ODO/TRIP switch is set, the
maintenance indicator comes on. For resetting, refer
to the following procedure (see page ME-23).
FUEL GAUGE
• For the purpose of correcting the calculation of the
fuel level by the meter ECU, 2 inclination sensors that
detect the vehicle's longitudinal and latitudinal
inclinations are installed in the meter ECU. The fuel
temperature sensor are installed in the fuel tank to
detect the temperature in the fuel tank.
• The fuel level is calculated by the meter ECU in
accordance with the signals of the sender gauge
located in the sub tank and the vehicle speed signal
received from the brake ECU. At this time, corrections
are made by the signals from the inclination sensor
that detect the vehicle's longitudinal and latitudinal
inclinations and the fuel temperature sensors that
detects the temperature in the fuel tank. For the
inclination sensor centered value setting, refer to the
following procedure (see page ME-23).
ME
ME–10
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
• Use these procedures to troubleshoot the meter / gauge
system.
• *: Use the intelligent tester.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
ME
INSPECT BATTERY VOLTAGE
Standard voltage:
11 to 14 V
If the voltage is below 11 V, recharge or replace the battery
before proceeding.
NEXT
3
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Result
Result
Proceed to
Fault is not listed in problem symptoms table
A
Fault is listed in problem symptoms table
B
B
Go to step 5
A
4
OVERALL ANALYSIS AND TROUBLESHOOTING*
(a) Terminals of ECU (see page ME-14)
(b) DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST (see page ME-23)
(c) On-vehicle Inspection (see page ME-23)
NEXT
5
NEXT
REPAIR OR REPLACE
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
6
ME–11
CONFIRMATION TEST
NEXT
END
ME
ME–12
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
CUSTOMIZE PARAMETERS
NOTICE:
Basically, these buzzers should be set on for safety
driving. However, only if it is necessary to set the buzzer
off for some reason, perform the following procedures.
Procedure
ME
Steps
Back-up Warning Buzzer
Driver's Seat Belt Buzzer
Front Passenger's Seat Belt
Buzzer
1
Turn power switch ON (IG)
Turn power switch ON (IG)
Turn power switch ON (IG)
2
Press ODO / TRIP switch until
odometer displays "ODO"
Press ODO / TRIP switch until
odometer displays "ODO"
Press ODO / TRIP switch until
odometer displays "ODO"
3
Turn power switch OFF
Turn power switch OFF
Turn power switch OFF
4
Turn power switch ON (IG) while
depressing brake pedal. Check
that combination meter displays
"READY"
Turn power switch ON (IG) while
depressing brake pedal. Check
that combination meter displays
"READY"
Turn power switch ON (IG) while
depressing brake pedal. Check
that combination meter displays
"READY"
5
After turning power switch ON
(IG), press ODO / TRIP switch
within 6 seconds, and hold it
down for 10 seconds or more
After turning power switch ON
(IG), press ODO / TRIP switch
within 6 seconds, and hold it
down for 10 seconds or more.
Sit in front passenger seat. After
turning the power switch ON (IG),
press ODO / TRIP switch within 6
seconds, and hold it down for 10
seconds or more.
6
Continue holding down ODO /
TRIP switch, move shift lever to R
and press P switch
Continue holding down ODO /
TRIP switch, fasten driver seat
belt
Continue holding down ODO /
TRIP switch, fasten front
passenger seat belt
7
Check that odometer displays
either "b-on" or "b-off"*
Check that odometer displays
either "b-on" or "b-off"*
Check that odometer displays
either "b-on" or "b-off"*
8
Press ODO / TRIP switch to
change display to "b-off"
Press ODO / TRIP switch to
change display to "b-off"
Press ODO / TRIP switch to
change display to "b-off"
9
Turn power switch OFF
Turn power switch OFF
Turn power switch OFF
10
Turn power switch ON (IG) while
depressing brake pedal. Check
that combination meter displays
"READY"
Turn power switch ON (IG) while
depressing brake pedal. Check
that combination meter displays
"READY"
Turn power switch ON (IG) while
depressing brake pedal. Check
that combination meter displays
"READY"
11
Check that no buzzer sounds
when shift lever is in "R"
Check that no buzzer sounds
Check that no buzzer sounds
when sitting on front passenger
seat
HINT:
*: "b-off" indicates that the buzzer is OFF. "b-on" indicates that
the buzzer is ON. The buzzer cancel setting will be finished
(the odometer will display "ODO") if the ODO / TRIP switch is
not operated for 10 seconds or more. In this case, perform
step 11 to check that buzzer cancel setting is complete. If it is
not complete, start from step 1 again.
NOTICE:
When either the battery cable or the combination meter
connector is disconnected, these buzzers are set on.
ME–13
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
• Use the table below to help determine the cause of the
problem symptom. The potential causes of the symptoms
are listed in order of probability in the "Suspected area"
column of the table. Check each symptom by checking the
suspected areas in the order they are listed. Replace parts
as necessary.
• Inspect the fuses and relays related to this system before
inspecting the suspected areas below.
Malfunction system
Symptom
Suspected area
See page
Entire combination meter does not operate
1. Refer to troubleshooting
ME-29
ODO / TRIP switch malfunction
1. Refer to troubleshooting
ME-41
Operating light control rheostat does not change light
brightness
1. Refer to troubleshooting
ME-43
Meter gauges
Symptom
Suspected area
See page
Speedometer malfunction
1. Refer to troubleshooting
ME-31
Fuel receiver gauge malfunction
1. Refer to troubleshooting
ME-34
Warning lights
Symptom
MIL does not turn on
Brake control warning light does not turn on
ABS warning light does not turn on
SRS warning light does not turn on
Open door warning light does not turn on
VSC warning light does not turn on
Suspected area
See page
1. Refer to troubleshooting
ES-428
2. Wire harness
-
3. Combination meter
-
1. Refer to troubleshooting
BC-186
2. Wire harness
-
3. Combination meter
-
1. Refer to troubleshooting
BC-170
2. Wire harness
-
3. Combination meter
-
1. Refer to troubleshooting
RS-165
2. Wire harness
-
3. Combination meter
-
1. Door courtesy light switch circuit
LI-54
2. Wire harness
-
3. Combination meter
-
1. Refer to troubleshooting
BC-175
2. Wire harness
-
3. Combination meter
-
Driver side seat belt warning light does not operate
1. Refer to troubleshooting
ME-36
Seat belt warning light for passengers seat does not
operate
1. Refer to troubleshooting
ME-38
Indicator lights
Symptom
Suspected area
1. Turn signal and hazard warning system
Turn indicator light does not turn on
See page
LI-123
2. Wire harness
-
3. Combination meter
-
ME
ME–14
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
Symptom
Suspected area
1. Headlight dimmer switch
High beam indicator light does not turn on
A/C AUTO indicator light does not turn on
Rr DEF indicator light does not turn on
Fr DEF indicator light does not turn on
RECIRCULATE indicator light does not turn on
HEAD indicator light does not turn on
ME
SMART indicator light does not turn on
SECURITY indicator light does not turn on
SLIP indicator light does not turn on
CRUISE indicator light does not turn on
All buzzers (key reminder, tail cancel, seat belt) do not
operate
See page
LI-106
2. Wire harness
-
3. Combination meter
-
1. Refer to troubleshooting
AC-23
2. Wire harness
-
3. Combination meter
-
1. Refer to troubleshooting
AC-23
2. Wire harness
-
3. Combination meter
-
1. Refer to troubleshooting
AC-23
2. Wire harness
-
3. Combination meter
-
1. Refer to troubleshooting
AC-23
2. Wire harness
-
3. Combination meter
-
1. Refer to troubleshooting
LI-69
2. Wire harness
-
3. Combination meter
-
1. Refer to troubleshooting
DL-185
2. Wire harness
-
3. Combination meter
-
1. Refer to troubleshooting
TD-36
2. Wire harness
-
3. Combination meter
-
1. Refer to troubleshooting
BC-187
2. Wire harness
-
3. Combination meter
-
1. ECM
-
2. Wire harness
-
3. Combination meter
-
1. Refer to troubleshooting
ME-10
2. Combination meter
-
Display warning
Symptom
Malfunction in HV system
Main battery low voltage malfunction
AT shift indicator light does not turn on
Charging malfunction
Water temperature display malfunction
Malfunction in transmission control system
Low engine oil pressure display malfunction
Suspected area
See page
1. Hybrid vehicle control ECU
HV-20
2. Combination meter
-
1. Hybrid vehicle control ECU
HV-20
2. Combination meter
-
1. Hybrid vehicle control ECU
HV-20
2. Combination meter
-
1. Hybrid vehicle control ECU
HV-20
2. Combination meter
-
1. ECM
-
2. Combination meter
-
1. Transmission control ECU
-
2. Combination meter
-
1. Engine oil pressure switch
-
2. Combination meter
-
ME–15
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
Symptom
Malfunction in EPS system
Malfunction in headlight leveling control
Suspected area
See page
1. Power steering ECU
-
2. Combination meter
-
1. Headlight control ECU
-
2. Combination meter
-
Buzzer
Symptom
Suspected area
1. Refer to troubleshooting
Key reminder warning buzzer does not sound
Light reminder warning buzzer does not sound
Seat belt warning buzzer does not sound
Headlight automatic leveling warning buzzer does not
sound
Warning buzzer does not sound (READY, A/T R, N/D
warning, HV system, Main battery, Charge, Shift reject)
Warning buzzer does not sound (Hi water temperature,
Oil pressure)
Warning buzzer does not sound (Smart key system)
Steering lock warning buzzer does not sound
See page
DL-209
2. Wire harness
-
3. Combination meter
-
1. Refer to troubleshooting
LI-69
2. Wire harness
-
3. Combination meter
-
1. Refer to troubleshooting
SB-4
2. Wire harness
-
3. Combination meter
-
1. Refer to troubleshooting
LI-69
2. Wire harness
-
3. Combination meter
-
1. Refer to troubleshooting
LI-69
2. Wire harness
-
3. Combination meter
-
1. Refer to troubleshooting
LI-69
2. Wire harness
-
3. Combination meter
-
1. Refer to troubleshooting
LI-69
2. Wire harness
-
3. Combination meter
-
1. Refer to troubleshooting
PS-11
2. Wire harness
-
3. Combination meter
-
ME
ME–16
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
CHECK COMBINATION METER (METER ECU)
C10
I040067E01
ME
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
km/h or mph (C10-1) Body ground
L - Body ground
km/h or mph signal
Power switch ON (ACC or
IG) and km/h or mph
switch ON
Below 1 V
Power switch ON (ACC or
IG) and km/h or mph
switch OFF
4 to 5.5 V
TRIP EARTH (C10-2) Body ground
B - Body ground
GND signal FOR ODO/
TRIP SWITCH
Always
Below 1 Ω
ODO/TRIP/RESET (C103) - Body ground
R - Body ground
ODO/TRIP/RESET signal
ODO/TRIP/RESET switch
ON
Below 1 V
ODO/TRIP/RESET switch
OFF
4 to 5.5 V
IG2 (C10-4) - Body ground
O - Body ground
Power switch signal
Power switch ON
10 to 14 V
Power switch OFF
Below 1 V
D-BELT SW (C10-6) Body ground
LG - Body ground
Driver seat belt condition
D-BELT indicator light ON
(IG)
Below 1 V
D-BELT indicator light
OFF
10 to 14 V
Passenger seat belt
condition
P-BELT indicator light ON
Below 1 V
P-BELT indicator light
OFF
10 to 14 V
SECURITY signal
Key is not inserted
10 to 14 V
Key is inserted
Below 1 V
P-BELT SW (C10-7) Body ground
R - Body ground
SECURITY (C10-8) Body ground
R - Body ground
SPEED IN (C10-9) - Body
ground
V - Body ground
Speed signal (Input)
Power switch ON (ACC or
IG) and turn the wheel
slowly
Pulse generation
(See waveform 1)
AUTO LVL (C10-10) Body ground
L - Body ground
Headlight automatic
leveling signal
Headlight leveling system
is normal
Below 1 V
Headlight leveling system
is malfunctioning
10 to 14 V
AIRBAG indicator light ON
Below 1 V
AIRBAG indicator light
OFF
8 to 14 V
AIRBAG (C10-11) - Body
ground
B - Body ground
AIRBAG signal
TEMP SSR- (C10-12) Body ground
L - Body ground
Outside temperature
signal
Always
4 to 5.5 V
4P OUT (C10-13) - Body
ground
V - Body ground
Speed signal (Output)
Power switch ON (ACC or
IG) and turn the wheel
slowly
Pulse generation
(See waveform 2)
SIGNAL EARTH (C10-14)
- Body ground
BR - Body ground
GND signal
Always
Below 1 Ω
ME–17
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
FUEL IN (C10-15) - Body
ground
B - Body ground
Fuel signal
Power switch ON (ACC or
IG) and fuel level is FULL
4.0 Ω
Power switch ON (ACC or
IG) and fuel level is
EMPTY
110 Ω
Turn signal RH indicator
light OFF
Below 1 V
Turn signal RH indicator
light ON
10 to 14 V
Turn signal LH indicator
light OFF
Below 1 V
Turn signal LH indicator
light ON
10 to 14 V
TURN R (C10-18) - Body
ground
TURN L (C10-19) - Body
ground
G - Body ground
Turn signal right
Y - Body ground
Turn signal left
TEMP SSR+ (C10-20) Body ground
R - Body ground
GND
Always
Below 1 Ω
+B (C10-21) - Body
ground
Y - Body ground
Power switch signal
Always
10 to 14 V
IG2 (C10-22) - Body
ground
V - Body ground
Power switch signal
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
Power switch OFF
Below 1 V
BACK-UP LP (C10-23) Body ground
P - Body ground
Power switch ON (ACC or
IG) and shift is except R
position
Below 1 V
Power switch ON (ACC or
IG) and shift is R position
10 to 14 V
Power switch ON (ACC or
IG) and MIL on
Below 1 V
Power switch ON (ACC or
IG) and MIL off
10 to 14 V
CHECK E/G (C10-26) Body ground
Back-up light signal
G - Body ground
MIL signal
TC (C10-28) - Body
ground
SB - Body ground
Tail cancel (light condition)
signal
Power switch ON (ACC or
IG)
Pulse generation
(See waveform 3)
TR (C10-29) - Body
ground
R - Body ground
Rheostat (light control)
signal
Light control dimmer
switch is OFF
Below 1 V
Light control dimmer
switch is TAIL / HEAD
10 to 14 V
Power switch ON (ACC or
IG) and sit on passenger
seat, seat belt unfastened
Below 1 V
Power switch ON (ACC or
IG) and sit on passenger
seat, seat belt fastened
10 to 14 V
Always
Below 1 V
P-BELT LP (C10-30) Body ground
FUEL EARTH (C10-31) Body ground
Y - Body ground
Passenger seat belt signal
BR - Body ground
GND for fuel sender
gauge
(a) Using an oscilloscope, check the signal waveform 1
of the meter.
Waveform 1 (Reference)
Waveform 1
GND
A005135E24
Item
Contents
Symbols (Terminal No.)
SPEED IN (C10-9) - Body ground
Tool setting
5 V/DIV., 20 msec./DIV.
Vehicle condition
Driving at approx. 20 km/h (12 mph)
HINT:
As vehicle speed increases, the wavelength
shortens.
ME
ME–18
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
(b) Using an oscilloscope, check the signal waveform 2
of the meter.
Waveform 2 (Reference)
Waveform 2
GND
Item
Contents
Symbols (Terminal No.)
4P OUT (C10-13) - Body ground
Tool setting
5 V/DIV., 10 msec./DIV.
Vehicle condition
Engine idle speed
HINT:
As vehicle speed increases, the wavelength
shortens.
A005138E17
(c) Using an oscilloscope, check the signal waveform 3
of the meter.
Waveform 3 (Reference)
Waveform 3
GND
ME
Item
Contents
Symbols (Terminal No.)
TC (C10-28) - Body ground
Tool setting
2 V/DIV., 1 msec./DIV.
Vehicle condition
Power switch ON (IG)
E065322E02
2.
HINT:
Waveform changes as illumination dims ("A"
becomes longer).
CHECK SUB WIRE HARNESS CONNECTOR
I040694E01
ME–19
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
A
B
I040695E01
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
SECURITY (A-1) - Body
ground
R - Body ground
SECURITY signal
Key is inserted
Below 1 V
Key is not inserted
10 to 14 V
D-BELT SW (A-3) - Body
ground
LG - Body ground
Driver seat belt condition
D-BELT indicator light ON
Below 1 V
D-BELT indicator light
OFF
10 to 14 V
SIGNAL EARTH (A-4) Body ground
BR - Body ground
GND signal
Always
Below 1 Ω
TRIP EARTH (A-5) - Body
ground
B - Body ground
GND signal FOR ODO/
TRIP SWITCH
km/h or mph (A-6) - Body
ground
L - Body ground
km/h or mph signal
Power switch ON (ACC or
IG) and km/h or mph
switch ON
Below 1 V
Power switch ON (ACC or
IG) and km/h or mph
switch OFF
4 to 5.5 V
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
Power switch OFF
Below 1 V
ODO/TRIP/RESET switch
ON
Below 1 V
ODO/TRIP/RESET switch
OFF
4 to 5.5 V
IG2 (A-7) - Body ground
ODO/TRIP/RESET (A-8) Body ground
O - Body ground
R - Body ground
Power switch signal
ODO/TRIP/RESET signal
SPEED IN (A-9) - Body
ground
V - Body ground
Speed signal (Input)
Power switch ON (ACC or
IG) and turn the wheel
slowly
Pulse generation
(See waveform 1)
CHECK E/G (A-10) - Body
ground
G - Body ground
MIL signal
Power switch ON (ACC or
IG) and MIL ON
Below 1 V
Power switch ON (ACC or
IG) and MIL OFF
10 to 14 V
Turn signal LH indicator
light OFF
Below 1 V
Turn signal LH indicator
light ON
10 to 14 V
Turn signal RH indicator
light ON
Below 1 V
Turn signal RH indicator
light OFF
10 to 14 V
Power switch ON (ACC or
IG) and shift is except R
position
Below 1 V
Power switch ON (ACC or
IG) and shift is R position
10 to 14 V
AIRBAG indicator light ON
Below 1 V
AIRBAG indicator light
OFF
8 to 14 V
TURN L (A-11) - Body
ground
TURN R (A-12) - Body
ground
BACK-UP LP (A-13) Body ground
AIRBAG (A-14) - Body
ground
Y - Body ground
G - Body ground
P - Body ground
B - Body ground
Turn signal left
Turn signal right
BACK-UP light signal
AIRBAG signal
ME
ME–20
Symbols (Terminals No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
TR (B-2) - Body ground
R - Body ground
Rheostat (light control)
signal
Light control dimmer
switch is TAIL / HEAD
Below 1 V
Light control dimmer
switch is OFF
10 to 14 V
Passenger seat belt
condition
P-BELT indicator light ON
Below 1 V
P-BELT indicator light
OFF
10 to 14 V
Headlight automatic
leveling signal
Headlight leveling system
is normal
Below 1 V
Headlight leveling system
is malfunctioning
10 to 14 V
GND
Always
Below 1 Ω
Always
10 to 14 V
P-BELT SW (B-4) - Body
ground
R - Body ground
AUTO LVL (B-5) - Body
ground
L - Body ground
TEMP SSR+ (B-8) - Body
ground
ME
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
R - Body ground
+B (B-9) - Body ground
Y - Body ground
Power switch signal
TEMP SSR- (B-10) - Body
ground
L - Body ground
Outside temperature
signal
IG2 (B-11) - Body ground
V - Body ground
Power switch signal
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
Power switch OFF
Below 1 V
FUEL IN (B-12) - Body
ground
B - Body ground
Fuel signal
Power switch ON (ACC or
IG) and fuel level is FULL
4.0 Ω
Power switch ON (ACC or
IG) and fuel level is
EMPTY
110 Ω
4 to 5.5 V
FUEL EARTH (B-13) Body ground
BR - Body ground
GND for fuel sender
gauge
Always
Below 1 Ω
4P OUT (B-14) - Body
ground
V - Body ground
Tachometer signal
(Output)
Power switch ON (ACC or
IG) and turn the wheel
slowly
Pulse generation
(See waveform 2)
TC (B-15) - Body ground
SB - Body ground
Taillight cancel (light
condition) signal
Power switch ON (ACC or
IG)
Pulse generation
(See waveform 3)
(a) Using an oscilloscope, check the signal waveform 1
of the meter.
Waveform 1 (Reference)
Waveform 1
GND
Item
Contents
Symbol (Terminal No.)
SPEED IN (A-9) - Body ground
Tool setting
5 V/DIV., 20 msec./DIV.
Vehicle condition
Driving at approx. 20 km/h (12 mph)
HINT:
As vehicle speed increases, the wavelength
shortens.
A005135E24
(b) Using an oscilloscope, check the signal waveform 2
of the meter.
Waveform 2 (Reference)
Waveform 2
GND
A005138E17
Item
Contents
Symbol (Terminal No.)
4P OUT (B-14) - Body ground
Tool setting
5 V/DIV., 10 msec./DIV.
Vehicle condition
Engine idle speed
HINT:
As vehicle speed increases, the wavelength
shortens.
ME–21
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
(c) Using an oscilloscope, check the signal waveform 3
of the meter.
Waveform 3 (Reference)
Waveform 3
GND
E065322E02
Item
Contents
Symbol (Terminal No.)
TC (B-15) - Body ground
Tool setting
2 V/DIV., 1 msec./DIV.
Vehicle condition
Power switch ON (IG)
HINT:
Waveform changes as illumination dims ("A"
becomes longer).
ME
ME–22
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
3.
C10-13
I/F
C10-9
I/F
COMBINATION METER INNER CIRCUIT
BEAN IN
C10-24
UFD
C10-15
BUZZER
I/F
I/F
C10-30
C10-31
C10-22
C10-20
C10-12
ME
C10-29
I/F
I/F
I/F
C10-23
I/F
C10-6
I/F
C10-10
RECIRCULATE
CPU
Rr DEF
TR
TR
Fr DEF
I/F
CRUISE
I/F
HEAD
C10-14
TIRE PRESSURE
C10-2
READY
C10-3
I/F
C10-1
I/F
C10-11
C10-21
A/C AUTO
I/F
C10-28
C10-7
C10-25
I/F
SLIP
ABS
TR
ECB
SRS
MASTER WRN
I102548E01
ME–23
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
MAINT REQUID
VSC
TR
SMART
D-BELT
BRAKE
TR
DOOR
BEAM
ME
MIL
C10-4
C10-26
SECURITY
C10-8
TURN L
C10-19
TURN R
C10-18
I102523E01
ME–24
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
Table of Terminal Connection
Terminal No.
Wire Harness Side
C10
1
ODO / TRIP Switch
2
3
4
IGN fuse
5
-
6
Front seat inner belt LH
7
Front seat inner belt RH
8
Body ECU
9
Skid control ECU
10
Headlight beam level control ECU
11
Center airbag sensor
12
Fuel sender gauge
13
4 Pulse output
14
Body ground
15
Fuel sender gauge
16
-
17
ME
18
Flasher relay
19
20
Fuel sender gauge
21
DOME fuse
22
GAUGE fuse
23
Back-up light relay
24
Certification ECU
25
Power source control ECU
26
ECM
27
-
28
Light control rheostat
29
PANEL fuse
30
Passenger seat belt warning light
31
Fuel sender gauge
32
-
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
CG
SG
1.
SIL
BAT
CHECK DLC3
The vehicle's combination meter (ECU) uses ISO 157654 for communication. The terminal arrangement of the
DLC3 complies with SAE J1962 and matches the ISO
15765-4 format. If there are any open or short circuits in
the chart below, perform troubleshooting with the "SFI
System" (see page ES-10).
H100769E18
Tester Connection
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
SIL (7) - SG (5)
Bus "+" line
During communication
Pulse generation
CG (4) - Body ground
Chassis ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
SG (5) - Body ground
Signal ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
BAT (16) - Body ground
Battery positive
Always
9 to 14 V
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
Intelligent Tester
CAN VIM
DLC3
A082795E04
ME–25
HINT:
If the display inidcates UNABLE TO CONNECT TO
VEHICLE when you have connected the cable of the
intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the DLC3, turned the
power switch ON (IG) and operated the tester, there is a
problem either on the vehicle side or tester side.
• If communication is normal when the tester is
connected to another vehicle, inspect the DLC3 on
the original vehicle.
• If communication is still not possible when the tester
is connected to another vehicle, the problem is
probably in the tester itself, so consult the Service
Department listed in the tester's instruction manual.
ME
ME–26
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST
1.
READ DATA LIST
HINT:
Using the intelligent tester's DATA LIST allows switch,
actuator and other item values to be read without
removing any parts. Reading the DATA LIST early in
troubleshooting is one way to save time.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Read the DATA LIST according to the display on the
tester.
ECM
ME
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
VEHICLE SPEED
Vehicle speed / Min.: 0 km/h (0
mph), Max.: 255 km/h (158 mph)
Almost the same as the actual
vehicle speed (When driving)
-
ENGINE SPD
Engine speed / Min.: 0 rpm, Max.:
16,383 rpm
Almost the same as the actual
engine speed (When engine is
running)
-
COOLANT TEMP
Coolant temperature / Min.: -40°C
(-40°F), Max.: 140°C (284°F)
After warming up: 80 to 95°C
(176 to 203°F)
If the value is "-40°C (-40°F)" or
"140°C (284°F)", sensor circuit is
open or shorted
Item
Measurement Item/ Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
(FR/FL/RR/RL) SPD
Vehicle speed / Min.: 0 km/h (0
mph), Max.: 326 km/h (202 mph)
Almost same as actual speed
(When driving)
-
Skid control ECU
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
ME–27
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
CHECK SPEEDOMETER
(a) Check the operation.
(1) Using a speedometer tester, inspect the
speedometer for indication error and check the
operation of the odometer.
Reference (km/h)
Standard indication
Acceptable range
20 km/h
18.0 to 22.0 km/h
40 km/h
38.0 to 42.0 km/h
60 km/h
58.0 to 62.0 km/h
80 km/h
78.0 to 82.0 km/h
100 km/h
97.0 to 103.0 km/h
120 km/h
117.0 to 123.0 km/h
140 km/h
137.0 to 143.0 km/h
160 km/h
157.0 to 163.0 km/h
Reference (mph)
Standard indication
Acceptable range
20 mph
18.0 to 22.0 mph
40 mph
38.0 to 42.0 mph
60 mph
59.0 to 63.0 mph
80 mph
79.0 to 83.0 mph
100 mph
99.0 to 104.0 mph
120 mph
119.0 to 125.0 mph
NOTICE:
Tire wear and over or under tire pressure
will affect indication error.
(2) Check the deflection width of the speedometer
indicator.
Reference:
Below 0.5 km/h (0.3 mph)
2.
C10-13
I039140E02
CHECK OUTPUT SIGNAL OF VEHICLE SPEED
(a) Check the output signal waveform.
(1) Remove the combination meter.
(2) Connect an oscilloscope to terminals C10-13
and the body ground.
(3) Start the engine.
ME
ME–28
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
(4) Check the signal waveform according to the
condition(s) in the table below.
Item
Condition
Tool setting
5 V/DIV., 20 msec./DIV.
Vehicle condition
Driving at approx. 20 km/h (12 mph)
GND
OK:
As shown in the illustration
HINT:
As vehicle speed increases, the cycle of the
signal waveform narrows.
A005135E27
Wire Harness Side
ME
3.
CHECK FUEL RECEIVER GAUGE
(a) Disconnect the F14 sender gauge connector.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG), then check the
position of the receiver gauge needle.
OK:
Needle position is on EMPTY.
(c) Connect terminals 5 and 6 on the wire harness side
connector of the fuel sender gauge.
(d) Turn the power switch to the ON (IG), then check
the position of the receiver gauge needle.
OK:
Needle position is on FULL.
4.
CHECK FUEL LEVEL WARNING
(a) Disconnect the connector from the sender gauge.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG), check that the fuel
level needle indicates EMPTY and fuel level
warning light comes on.
OK:
Fuel level warning light comes on.
5.
CHECK LOW OIL PRESSURE WARNING LIGHT
(a) Disconnect the connector from the low oil pressure
switch.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Ground the terminal of the wire harness side
connector, then check the low oil pressure warning
light.
OK:
Low oil pressure warning light comes on.
6.
CHECK BRAKE WARNING LIGHT
(a) Inspect the parking brake warning light.
(1) Disconnect the connector from the parking
brake switch.
(2) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(3) Ground the terminal of the wire harness side
connector, then check the parking brake
warning light.
OK:
Brake warning light comes on.
(b) Inspect the brake fluid level warning light.
(1) Disconnect the connector from the brake fluid
level warning switch.
(2) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
F14
I040065E05
ME–29
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
(3) Connect a terminal to the other terminal of the
wire harness side connector, then check the
brake fluid level warning switch.
OK:
Brake warning light comes on.
7.
CHECK BRAKE FLUID LEVEL WARNING SWITCH
(a) Remove the reservoir tank cap and strainer.
(b) Disconnect the connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the terminals.
Standard resistance:
Float up (switch off): 10 kΩ or higher
(d) Use a syphon, etc. to take fluid out of the reservoir
tank.
(e) Measure the resistance between the terminals.
Standard resistance:
Float up (switch off): 10 kΩ or higher
(f) Pour the fluid back in the reservoir tank.
(g) Reconnect the connector.
8.
MAINTENANCE LIQUID RESETTING PROCEDURE
(U. S. A. models)
Indicator condition
State
Condition
Specified State
Blinking
Vehicle runs 4,500 miles after previous setting
Indicator blinks for 15 seconds after power
switch ON (IG) (including 3 seconds for a
valve check)
Continuously Illuminated
Vehicle runs 5,000 miles after previous setting
Indicator is continuously illuminated after
power switch ON (IG)
(a) Press the ODO / TRIP switch until odometer
displays "ODO".
(b) Turn the power switch OFF.
(c) Press and hold the reset switch, and turn the power
switch ON (IG).
(d) After turning the power switch ON (IG), keep holding
the reset switch for at least 5 seconds. The reset
procedure is completed.
HINT:
• If the power switch is turned OFF during reset
procedure, reset mode is canceled.
• If the reset switch is turned off during the reset
procedure, reset mode is canceled and the
display shows the condition prior to the reset
procedure.
9.
CENTERED VALUE SETTING (INCLINATION
SENSOR)
Perform the following procedures to correct inclination of
the meter and inclination sensors when installing /
removing / replacing the meter or after replacing the
inclination sensors or main base.
ME
ME–30
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
(a) Setting procedure
(1) Connect the connector and install the meter
securely in the position shown in the illustration
so that it is inclined at a 20 degree angle to the
vehicle's vertical line A.
20°
ME
Vehicle Horizontal Line
Vertical Line “A”
I102520E01
(2) Park the vehicle on a level surface.
(3) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(4) Set the odometer display into the "TRIP A"
mode.
(5) Turn the power switch OFF.
(6) Press and hold the ODO/TRIP switch while
pressing the power switch twice ON (IG). (Do
not put your foot on the brake.)
(7) Press the ODO/TRIP button (switch?) 3 times
within 5 seconds and hold it at least 5 seconds
until the Inclination Sensor Information is
displayed on the odometer.
(8) Release the ODO/TRIP switch.
(9) Press and hold the ODO/TRIP switch for at
least 5 seconds to update the centered value.
The third digit will indicate the status. The value
of "1" indicates a successful reset.
HINT:
• If "0", "2", or "3" is displayed, perform the
procedure "Turn the power switch ON (IG)"
again.
• Once the reset is complete, the odometer
will returns to normal.
(10) Release the ODO/TRIP button. (Once the reset
is complete, the odometer will returns to
normal.)
ME–31
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
(11) Turn the power switch OFF.
Current Result Display
Display in Setting Mode
Sensor A/C value
Front-rear *4 Right-left
direction
direction
sensor info. Area code for A/C value*1
sensor info.
0: Input state
1: Input start completed
2: E2ROM error
3: Speed input during input state
or cancel during ODO input state
*1:
0: Horizontal
1: 3 to 5°
2: Over 5°
3: Error
Timing Chart for Inclination Sensor Setting
Power Switch ON
OFF
ME
Within 5 seconds
5 seconds or more 5 seconds
ODO/TRIP
Switch
ON
OFF
Display Indication
5 seconds or more
*2
*3
*4
I102521E01
*2: ODO/TRIP display (Normal mode)
*3: Inclination sensor information display
(Setting mode)
*4: Current result display
ME–32
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
Entire Combination Meter does not Operate
WIRING DIAGRAM
Combination Meter
IG1
GAUGE
from Battery
from Power Source
Control ECU
DOME
from Battery
ME
AM2
from Battery
IG2
IGN
from Power Source
Control ECU
E125435E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (METER - BATTERY AND BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the C10 meter connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
C10
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
C10-21 - Body ground
Always
10 to 14 V
C10-4 - Body ground
Power switch ON (IG)
C10-22 - Body ground
I102401E01
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
ME–33
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
C10-14 - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
ME
ME–34
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
Speedometer Malfunction
WIRING DIAGRAM
Combination Meter
Skid Control ECU
S1
SP1
ME
E115290E21
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (VEHICLE SPEED SIGNAL)
(a) Check the DATA LIST for proper functioning of the
vehicle speed signal.
Skid control ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
(FR/FL/RR/RL) SPD
Vehicle speed / Min.: 0 km/h (0
mph), Max.: 326 km/h (202
mph)
Almost same as actual speed
(When driving)
-
OK:
Vehicle speed displayed on the tester is almost the
same as the actual vehicle speed.
NG
OK
GO TO ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED
BRAKE SYSTEM
ME–35
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
2
CHECK COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
(a) Using an oscilloscope, check the signal waveform of the
meter.
Tester Connection
Tool Setting
Vehicle Condition
C10-9 - Body ground
5 V/DIV., 20 msec./DIV.
Driving at approx. 20 km/
h (12 mph)
OK:
Refer to the illumination.
HINT:
As the vehicle speed increases, the wavelength
shortens.
C10-9
OK
REPLACE COMBINATION METER
ME
GND
E125457E01
NG
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ECU - METER)
Wire Harness Side
S8
Skid Control ECU
(a) Disconnect the S8 ECU connector.
(b) Disconnect the C10 meter connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
C10-9 - S8-22 (SP1)
Below 1 Ω
C10-9 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
SP1
Combination Meter
C10
E125677E01
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
ME–36
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
OK
GO TO ELECTRONICALLY CONTROLLED BRAKE SYSTEM
ME
ME–37
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
Fuel Receiver Gauge Malfunction
WIRING DIAGRAM
Combination Meter
Fuel Sender Gauge
ME
E125458E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
The inclination sensor is built into the combination meter (see page ME-23).
1
CHECK COMBINATION METER
Wire Harness Side
F14
I040065E05
(a) Disconnect the F14 sender gauge connector.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and check the position of
the sender gauge needle.
OK:
Fuel gauge indicates E.
(c) Connect terminals 5 and 6 on the wire harness side
connector.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and check the position of
the receiver gauge needle.
OK:
Fuel gauge indicates F.
(e) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
F14-5 - Body ground
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
NG
OK
Go to step 3
ME–38
2
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
INSPECT FUEL SENDER GAUGE ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the F14 gauge connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the gauge connector.
Standard resistance
I041218E01
Tester Connection
Fuel level
Specified Condition
5-6
Full
Approx. 4 Ω
Half
Approx. 40 to 60 Ω
Empty
Approx. 110 Ω
NG
REPLACE FUEL TANK ASSEMBLY
OK
REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
ME
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (GAUGE - METER)
(a) Disconnect the F14 gauge connector.
(b) Disconnect the C12 meter connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Fuel Sender Gauge
F14
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
F14-6 - C10-31
Below 1 Ω
F14-5 - C10-15
NG
Combination Meter
C10
E125678E01
OK
REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
ME–39
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
Driver Side Seat Belt Warning Light does not Operate
WIRING DIAGRAM
Combination Meter
Front Seat Inner Belt LH
E125461E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY LH (BUCKLE SWITCH)
(a) Remove the front seat inner belt LH.
(b) Measure the resistance of the buckle switch.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
Seat belt is unfastened
Below 1 Ω
Seat belt is fastened
10 kΩ or higher
NG
I040072E02
OK
REPLACE FRONT SEAT INNER BELT
ASSEMBLY LH
ME
ME–40
2
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (INNER BELT LH - METER AND BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the B15 belt connector.
(b) Disconnect the C10 meter connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Front Seat Inner Belt LH
B15
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
C10-6 - B15-2
Below 1 Ω
B15-1 - Body ground
NG
Combination Meter
C10
ME
C10-6
I040074E02
OK
REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
ME–41
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
Seat Belt Warning Light for Passenger Seat does not Flash
WIRING DIAGRAM
Front Passenger Seat Belt Warning Light
Combination Meter
from Battery
PASSENGER
Center Airbag Sensor
ME
E127622E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DTC
(a) Clear the DTC (see page RS-182).
(b) Check for DTC (see page RS-182).
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC B1771 is not output
A
DTC B1771 is output
B
B
A
GO TO OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION
SYSTEM
ME–42
2
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT PASSENGER SEAT BELT WARNING LIGHT
(a) Disconnect the C10 meter connector.
(b) Using a service wire, connect the meter terminal 30 on
the wire harness side and body ground.
(c) Check that the passenger seat belt warning light turns
on.
OK:
Front passenger seat belt warning light turns on.
Wire Harness Side
C10
NG
Go to step 4
I102401E01
OK
3
ME
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (METER - SENSOR)
(a) Disconnect the A18 sensor connector.
(b) Disconnect the C10 meter connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Center Airbag Sensor
A18
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A18-13 (PBEW) - C10-7
Below 1 Ω
NG
PBEW
Combination Meter
C10
I102543E01
OK
REPLACE COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
ME–43
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (WARNING LIGHT - METER AND BATTERY)
Wire Harness Side
Front Passenger Seat Belt Warning Light
F11
1 2 3
(a) Disconnect the F11 warning light connector.
(b) Disconnect the C10 meter connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
F11-4 (PBEW) - C10-30
Below 1 Ω
(d) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard resistance
4 5 6
PBEW
Combination Meter
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
F11-6 (IG+) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
NG
C10
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
ME
I102542E01
OK
REPLACE FRONT PASSENGER SEAT BELT WARNING LIGHT
ME–44
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
Odo / Trip Switch Malfunction
WIRING DIAGRAM
ODO / TRIP Switch
Combination Meter
E
ODO
I102419E01
ME
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT ODO / TRIP SWITCH
(a) Remove the ODO / TRIP switch.
(b) Measure the resistance of the switch.
Standard resistance
E
OK
ODO
E113999E03
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
5 (ODO) - 6 (E)
Push ODO / TRIP
switch
Below 1 Ω
Release ODO / TRIP
switch
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPLACE ODO / TRIP SWITCH
ME–45
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SWITCH - METER)
(a) Disconnect the H11 switch connector.
(b) Disconnect the C10 meter connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
ODO / TRIP Switch
H11
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
H11-5 (ODO) - C10-3
Below 1 Ω
H11-6 (E) - C10-2
ODO E
NG
Combination Meter
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
C10
ME
C10-2
C10-3
I040071E07
OK
REPLACE COMBINATION METER
ME–46
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
Operating Light Control Rheostat does not Change Light Brightness
WIRING DIAGRAM
Combination Meter
Light Control Rheostat
TC
T
to PANEL Fuse
E
I102544E01
ME
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT LIGHT CONTROL RHEOSTAT
(a) Remove the light control rheostat.
(b) Measure the resistance of the rheostat.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
5 (T) - 8 (TC)
Not in tail cancel
position
Below 1 Ω
Tail cancel position
(rheostat knob is fully
turned up)
10 kΩ or higher
T
TC
I102547E01
NG
OK
REPLACE LIGHT CONTROL RHEOSTAT
ME–47
METER – METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (RHEOSTAT - METER, BATTERY AND BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the R7 rheostat connector.
(b) Disconnect the C10 meter connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Light Control Rheostat
R7
1 2 3 4 5
6 7 8 9 10
TC
E
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
R7-8 (TC) - C10-28
Below 1 Ω
R7-3 (E) - Body ground
(d) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard voltage
T
Combination Meter
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
R7-5 (T) - Body ground
Light control switch is
TAIL
10 to 14 V
C10
NG
I102545E01
OK
REPLACE COMBINATION METER
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
ME
METER – COMBINATION METER
ME–45
COMBINATION METER
BODY ELECTRICAL
METER
COMPONENTS
NO. 1 COMBINATION METER COVER
NO. 2 COMBINATION METER COVER
METER CIRCUIT PLATE
NO. 2 METER CIRCUIT PLATE
NO. 2 COMBINATION METER CASE
ME
NO. 1 COMBINATION METER REFLECTOR
NO. 3 METER CIRCUIT PLATE
NO. 3 COMBINATION
METER CASE
NO. 4 METER CIRCUIT PLATE
COMBINATION METER CASE
NO. 3 COMBINATION METER COVER
B126628E01
ME–46
METER – COMBINATION METER
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the instrument panel (see page IP-5).
2.
REMOVE COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY (See
page IP-9)
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE NO. 1 COMBINATION METER COVER
(a) Remove the 2 screws.
B075521E01
(b) Detach the 2 claws, and then remove the
combination meter cover.
ME
B075522E03
2.
REMOVE METER CIRCUIT PLATE
NOTICE:
When disassembling the combination meter
assembly, eliminate static electricity by touching the
vehicle body to prevent the components from being
damaged.
(a) Pull the connector lock in the direction indicated by
the arrow in the illustration and separate the No. 3
meter circuit plate from the meter circuit plate.
B075523E01
(b) Detach the 5 claws, and then remove the meter
circuit plate.
3.
B075524E03
REMOVE NO. 2 COMBINATION METER CASE
METER – COMBINATION METER
4.
ME–47
REMOVE NO. 2 COMBINATION METER COVER
NOTICE:
When disassembling the combination meter
assembly, eliminate static electricity by touching the
vehicle body to prevent the components from being
damaged.
(a) Remove the 2 screws.
B075525E01
(b) Detach the 2 claws, and then remove the
combination meter cover.
ME
B075526E03
5.
REMOVE NO. 2 METER CIRCUIT PLATE
NOTICE:
When disassembling the combination meter
assembly, eliminate static electricity by touching the
vehicle body to prevent the components from being
damaged.
(a) Pull the connector lock in the direction indicated by
the arrow in the illustration and separate the No. 4
meter circuit plate from the No. 2 meter circuit plate.
B075527E01
(b) Detach the 4 claws, and then remove the meter
circuit plate.
6.
REMOVE NO. 3 COMBINATION METER CASE
7.
REMOVE NO. 1 COMBINATION METER REFLECTOR
(a) Remove the 4 clips.
B075528E05
2
1
2
B075529E01
ME–48
METER – COMBINATION METER
(b) Remove the screw and combination meter reflector.
B075530E01
ME
8.
REMOVE NO. 3 COMBINATION METER COVER
(a) Remove the 4 screws.
(b) Release the 2 claws of the cover, as shown in the
illustration.
(c) Raise the cover from the bottom and remove the
combination meter cover.
9.
REMOVE NO. 3 METER CIRCUIT PLATE
NOTICE:
When disassembling the combination meter
assembly, eliminate static electricity by touching the
vehicle body to prevent the components from being
damaged.
(a) Pull the connector lock in the direction indicated by
the arrow in the illustration, and remove the meter
circuit plate.
B075531E04
B075532E01
10. REMOVE NO. 4 METER CIRCUIT PLATE
NOTICE:
When disassembling the combination meter
assembly, eliminate static electricity by touching the
vehicle body to prevent the components from being
damaged.
(a) Pull the connector lock in the direction indicated by
the arrow in the illustration, and remove the meter
circuit plate.
B075533E01
11. REMOVE COMBINATION METER CASE
METER – COMBINATION METER
ME–49
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL COMBINATION METER CASE
2.
INSTALL NO. 4 METER CIRCUIT PLATE
NOTICE:
When reassembling the combination meter
assembly, eliminate static electricity by touching the
vehicle body to prevent the components from being
damaged.
(a) Push the connector lock in the direction indicated by
the arrow in the illustration, and install the meter
circuit plate.
3.
INSTALL NO. 3 METER CIRCUIT PLATE
NOTICE:
When reassembling the combination meter
assembly, eliminate static electricity by touching the
vehicle body to prevent the components from being
damaged.
(a) Push the connector lock in the direction indicated by
the arrow in the illustration, and install the meter
circuit plate.
B132966
B132965
4.
INSTALL NO. 3 COMBINATION METER COVER
(a) Attach the 2 claws to install the combination meter
cover.
(b) Install the 4 screws.
5.
INSTALL NO. 1 COMBINATION METER REFLECTOR
(a) Install the combination reflector with the screw.
B132964
B075530E02
ME
ME–50
METER – COMBINATION METER
(b) Install the 4 clips.
6.
INSTALL NO. 3 COMBINATION METER CASE
7.
INSTALL NO. 2 METER CIRCUIT PLATE
NOTICE:
When reassembling the combination meter
assembly, eliminate static electricity by touching the
vehicle body to prevent the components from being
damaged.
(a) Attach the 4 claws to install the meter circuit plate.
B132962
ME
B075528E04
(b) Push the connector lock in the direction indicated by
the arrow in the illustration and install the No. 4
meter circuit plate from the No. 2 meter circuit plate.
B132961
8.
INSTALL NO. 2 COMBINATION METER COVER
NOTICE:
When reassembling the combination meter
assembly, eliminate static electricity by touching the
vehicle body to prevent the components from being
damaged.
(a) Attach the 2 claws to install the combination meter
cover.
B075526E04
(b) Install the 2 screws.
9.
B075525E02
INSTALL NO. 2 COMBINATION METER CASE
METER – COMBINATION METER
ME–51
10. INSTALL METER CIRCUIT PLATE
NOTICE:
When reassembling the combination meter
assembly, eliminate static electricity by touching the
vehicle body to prevent the components from being
damaged.
(a) Attach the 5 claws to install the meter circuit plate.
B075524E04
(b) Push the connector lock in the direction indicated by
the arrow in the illustration and install the No. 3
meter circuit plate to the meter circuit plate.
ME
B132963
11. INSTALL NO. 1 COMBINATION METER COVER
(a) Attach the 2 claws to install the combination meter
cover.
B075522E04
(b) Install the 2 screws.
B075521E02
ME–52
METER – COMBINATION METER
INSTALLATION
ME
1.
INSTALL COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY (See
page IP-10)
2.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the instrument panel (see page IP-11).
MI–1
MIRROR – POWER MIRROR CONTROL SYSTEM
POWER MIRROR CONTROL SYSTEM
MIRROR
BODY
PARTS LOCATION
DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
- ACC FUSE
- AM2 FUSE
- ACC-B FUSE
OUTER REAR
VIEW MIRROR RH
OUTER REAR
VIEW MIRROR
LH
MI
ACC RELAY
OUTER MIRROR SWITCH
Left/Right Adjustment
Switch
Outer Mirror Switch
B127647E01
MI–2
MIRROR – POWER MIRROR CONTROL SYSTEM
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
Outer Mirror Switch
B
from Multiplex Communication System
Left
Right
Up
Mirror
Switch
Down
Left/ Right/
Up
Down
Select
Switch
SSW1
AM1
SSW2
HL
HR
VL
VR
M+
E
ACCD
ACC
Power Source
Control ECU
ACC
AM2
MI
MH MV
ACC-B
M
M+
M
Outer Rear View
Mirror LH
from Battery
MH MV
M
M+
M
Outer Rear View
Mirror RH
from Battery
B127648E01
MI–3
MIRROR – POWER MIRROR CONTROL SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
Use the table below to help determine the cause of the
problem symptom. The potential causes of the symptoms are
listed in order of probability in the "Suspected area" column of
the table. Check each symptom by checking the suspected
areas in the order they are listed. Replace parts as
necessary.
Power mirror control system
Symptom
Mirror does not operate
Mirror operates abnormally
Suspected area
See page
1. ACC fuse
MI-1
2. AM2 fuse
MI-1
3. ACC-B fuse
MI-1
4. ACC relay
MI-1
5. Outer mirror switch assembly
MI-14
6. Outer rear view mirror assembly
MI-10
7. Wire harness
-
1. ACC fuse
MI-1
2. AM2 fuse
MI-1
3. ACC-B fuse
MI-1
4. ACC relay
MI-1
5. Outer mirror switch assembly
MI-14
6. Outer rear view mirror assembly
MI-10
7. Wire harness
-
MI
MI–4
MIRROR – INNER REAR VIEW MIRROR
INNER REAR VIEW MIRROR
MIRROR
BODY
COMPONENTS
w/ EC Mirror
INNER REAR VIEW
MIRROR COVER
INNER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSEMBLY
MI
INNER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSEMBLY
B129178E01
MIRROR – INNER REAR VIEW MIRROR
MI–5
REMOVAL
HINT:
EC mirror stands for "electrochromic mirror".
1.
REMOVE INNER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSEMBLY
(w/o EC Mirror)
(a) Push the cover in the direction indicated by the
arrows labeled A and remove it.
(b) While holding down the claw in the direction
indicated by the black arrow labeled B, slide the
mirror in the direction indicated by the white arrow
and remove it.
2.
REMOVE INNER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSEMBLY
(w/ EC Mirror)
(a) Remove the inner rear view mirror cover.
(b) Remove the screw.
(c) Slide the mirror in the direction indicated by the
arrow in the illustration and remove the mirror.
A
Cover
A
Claw
B
B064964E02
MI
B056435E02
MI–6
MIRROR – INNER REAR VIEW MIRROR
INSPECTION
1.
10
8
Battery
INSPECT INNER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSEMBLY
(w/ EC Mirror)
(a) Check operation of the electrochromic inner mirror.
(1) Connect the battery's positive (+) lead to
terminal 10 and the negative (-) lead to terminal
8.
(2) Attach black colored tape to the forward sensor
to block it.
(3) Light up the mirror with an electric light, and
check that the mirror surface changes from
bright to dark.
If the result is not as specified, replace the
mirror assembly.
Sensor
Black Colored Tape
Bright
Dark
B137708E04
INSTALLATION
MI
1.
Cover
Claw
B113835E01
INSTALL INNER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSEMBLY
(w/o EC Mirror)
(a) Install the mirror in the direction of the white arrow.
(b) Install the cover as shown in the illustration.
MIRROR – INNER REAR VIEW MIRROR
2.
MI–7
INSTALL INNER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSEMBLY
(w/ EC Mirror)
(a) Install the mirror.
(b) Install the screw.
(c) Install the inner rear view mirror cover.
B056435E05
MI
MI–8
MIRROR – OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR
OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR
MIRROR
BODY
COMPONENTS
OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSEMBLY LH
MIRROR
MIRROR COVER
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
DOOR PULL HANDLE
FRONT DOOR TRIM BOARD
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
MI
FRONT DOOR LOWER FRAME
BRACKET GARNISH LH
FRONT DOOR INSIDE
HANDLE BEZEL LH
for RH Side
FRONT DOOR ARMREST
UPPER BASE PANEL
FRONT DOOR ARMREST
UPPER BASE PANEL
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B135938E01
MIRROR – OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR
MI–9
REMOVAL
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the LH side and RH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR INSIDE HANDLE BEZEL LH
(See page ED-11)
3.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR LOWER FRAME BRACKET
GARNISH LH (See page ED-11)
4.
REMOVE DOOR PULL HANDLE (See page ED-11)
5.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR ARMREST BASE PANEL
UPPER (See page ED-11)
6.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR TRIM BOARD SUBASSEMBLY LH (See page ED-12)
7.
REMOVE OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSEMBLY
LH
(a) Disconnect the mirror connector.
(b) Remove the 3 nuts and mirror.
8.
REMOVE OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSEMBLY
LH
(a) Using a moulding remover, detach the 4 claws and
outer rear view mirror.
HINT:
Apply protective tape to the mirror body.
B075148E01
Protective Tape
B137710E01
MI
MI–10
MIRROR – OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR
(b) Disconnect the 2 connectors and remove the mirror.
B136005
(c) Using a screwdriver, detach the 6 claws and remove
the mirror cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
B076118E01
INSPECTION
1.
(A)
(C)
(D)
(B)
MI
MH
M+
MV
B070997E04
INSPECT OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSEMBLY
LH
(a) Disconnect the mirror connector.
(b) Apply battery voltage and check the operation of the
mirror.
OK
Measurement Condition
Specified
Condition
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 5 (MV)
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 4 (M+)
Turns upward
(A)
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 4 (M+)
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 5 (MV)
Turns
downward (B)
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 3 (MH)
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 4 (M+)
Turns left (C)
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 4 (M+)
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 3 (MH)
Turns right (D)
If the result is not as specified, replace the mirror
assembly.
MI–11
MIRROR – OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR
(c) Apply battery voltage to the mirror terminals and
check the operation of the mirror heater.
OK
Measurement Condition
Specified
Condition
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 2 (M+)
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 1 (M-)
Mirror becomes
warm
If the result is not as specified, replace the mirror
assembly.
MM+
B076304E01
2.
(A)
(C)
(D)
(B)
MH
M+
MV
B070998E03
INSPECT OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSEMBLY
RH
(a) Disconnect the mirror connector.
(b) Apply battery voltage and check the operation of the
mirror.
OK
Measurement Condition
Specified
Condition
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 5 (MV)
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 4 (M+)
Turns upward
(A)
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 4 (M+)
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 5 (MV)
Turns downward
(B)
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 3 (MH)
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 4 (M+)
Turns left (C)
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 4 (M+)
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 3 (MH)
Turns right (D)
If the result is not as specified, replace the mirror
assembly.
(c) Apply battery voltage to the mirror terminals and
check the operation of the mirror heater.
OK
Measurement Condition
Specified
Condition
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 2 (M+)
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 1 (M-)
Mirror becomes
warm
If the result is not as specified, replace the mirror
assembly.
MM+
B076303E01
MI
MI–12
MIRROR – OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL OUTER MIRROR COVER LH
(a) Install the mirror cover as shown in the illustration.
B075311E01
(b) Check that there is no gap between the cover and
mirror body.
HINT:
If there is a gap between the cover and body, noise
will occur during driving.
Mirror Body
Mirror Cover
B076333E01
(c) Connect the 2 connectors.
MI
B136005
(d) Attach the 4 claws to install the mirror.
B075313E01
MIRROR – OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR
MI–13
2.
INSTALL OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSEMBLY
LH
(a) Install the mirror with the 3 nuts.
Torque: 5.5 N*m (56 kgf*cm, 49 in.*lbf)
(b) Connect the connector.
3.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR TRIM BOARD SUBASSEMBLY LH (See page ED-21)
4.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR ARMREST BASE PANEL
UPPER LH (See page ED-21)
5.
INSTALL DOOR PULL HANDLE (See page ED-22)
6.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR LOWER FRAME BRACKET
GARNISH LH (See page ED-22)
7.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR INSIDE HANDLE BEZEL LH
(See page ED-22)
8.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page SS-2).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
B075148E01
MI
MI–14
MIRROR – OUTER MIRROR SWITCH
OUTER MIRROR SWITCH
LEFT
RIGHT
INSPECTION
Left/Right Adjustment Switch
1.
Mirror
Switch
UP
LEFT
DOWN
No Pin
B
RIGHT
MRV
E
M+
MLH
MLV
No Pin
MRH
B059702E03
INSPECT OUTER MIRROR SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) The L position of the left/right adjustment switch:
Measure the resistance of the mirror switch.
Standard resistance (for left side)
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
4 (MLV) - 8 (B)
6 (M+) - 7 (E)
UP
Below 1 Ω
4 (MLV) - 7 (E)
6 (M+) - 8 (B)
DOWN
Below 1 Ω
5 (MLH) - 8 (B)
6 (M+) - 7 (E)
LEFT
Below 1 Ω
5 (MLH) - 7 (E)
6 (M+) - 8 (B)
RIGHT
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the switch
assembly.
(b) The R position of the left/right adjustment switch:
Measure the resistance of the mirror switch.
Standard resistance (for right side)
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
3 (MRV) - 8 (B)
6 (M+) - 7 (E)
UP
Below 1 Ω
3 (MRV) - 7 (E)
6 (M+) - 8 (B)
DOWN
Below 1 Ω
2 (MRH) - 8 (B)
6 (M+) - 7 (E)
LEFT
Below 1 Ω
2 (MRH) - 7 (E)
6 (M+) - 8 (B)
RIGHT
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the switch
assembly.
MI
MI–15
MIRROR – MIRROR HEATER RELAY
MIRROR HEATER RELAY
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
1
3
5
2
1
(b) Measure the resistance of the relay.
Standard resistance
2
5
3
B060778E04
INSPECT MIRROR HEATER RELAY
(a) Remove the mirror heater relay.
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to
terminals 1 and 2)
If the result is not as specified, replace the relay.
(c) Install the mirror heater relay.
MI
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
MP–1
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION
SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
NOTICE:
• When disconnecting the cable from the negative (-)
battery terminal, initialize the following system after
the cable is reconnected.
• When the warning light is illuminated or the battery
has been disconnected, pressing the power switch
may not start the system on the first try. If so, press
the power switch again.
System Name
See Procedure
Power Window Control System
IN-32
MP
MP–2
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
BEAN BUS
CERTIFICATION ECU*
COMBINATION METER
TIRE PRESSURE
MONITOR ECU
GATEWAY ECU
POWER SOURCE
CONTROL ECU
TRANSPONDER KEY ECU
TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU
DLC3
A/C ECU
DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
- MAIN BODY ECU
MP
*: w/ Smart Key
B126158E02
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
MP–3
AVC-LAN BUS
MULTI-DISPLAY
GATEWAY ECU
RADIO AND PLAYER
DLC3
NAVIGATION ECU*
*: w/ Navigation System
B126159E02
MP
MP–4
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
*1: w/ Navigation
: AVC-LAN
: BEAN
*2: w/ JBL Audio
*3: w/ VSC
: CAN
Gateway ECU
Multi-display
*4: w/ Smart Key
Navigation
ECU*1
Radio and Player
Audio
Amplifier*2
ECM
HV ECU
Yaw Rate and
Deceleration Sensor*3
Power Source
Control ECU
Combination
Meter
Tire Pressure
Monitor ECU
Certification
ECU*4
Junction Connector 2
Battery ECU
Transmission
Control ECU
ABS ECU
Transponder
Key ECU
EPS ECU
Junction Connector 1
MP
Steering Angle
Sensor*3
DLC3
Driver Side
Junction Block
A/C ECU
B133175E04
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
MP–5
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
MPX (MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION NETWORK)
The MPX connects the ECUs of this vehicle and uses an
ON-OFF signal (binary 0 and 1) to communicate with
each ECU. The ECU operates the actuator based on the
other ECU information. For example, the ECM (PCM)
allows the engine to start based on the transponder key
ECU information. The MPX consists of 3 networks: AVCLAN (Audio Visual Communication Local Area Network),
BEAN (Body Electronics Area Network) and CAN
(Controller Area Network). The gateway ECU is
connected to and coordinates communication between
the 3 networks.
MPX Cross-reference
Network
Protocol
Wire Harness
AVC-LAN
TOYOTA original
Twisted twin wire
Maximum 17,800 bps*
0 to 32 byte
BEAN
TOYOTA original
Single line
Maximum 10,000 bps*
1 to 11 byte
CAN
ISO 15765-4
Twisted twin wire
500,000 bps* (Maximum 1
Mbps)
1 to 8 byte
2.
Speed
Data length
HINT:
*: "bps" indicates bits per second.
AVC-LAN (AUDIO VISUAL COMMUNICATION LOCAL
AREA NETWORK)
The audio/visual system uses the AVC-LAN. The master
ECU is connected to gateway ECU and sends the signal
to the other ECUs. The wire harness is a twisted twin
wire covered with the insulation. One wire is used for the
positive voltage and the other wire is used for the
negative voltage.
ECU
Gateway ECU
ECU
Master ECU
(Multi-display)
ECU
MP
B133172E01
MP–6
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
3.
Gateway ECU
BEAN (BODY ELECTRONICS AREA NETWORK)
The body electrical system uses the BEAN. The ECUs
are connected to the gateway ECU like a daisy chain.
This maintains the communication if the wire harness
has an open circuit. The wire harness is a signal core
line covered with insulation.
ECU
ECU
ECU
ECU
ECU
ECU
B133173E01
4.
MP
CAN (COMMUNICATION AREA NETWORK)
The powertrain and chassis system use the CAN. The
CAN circuit has 2 master ECUs. One master ECU is
connected to the other master ECU by the main wire.
The gateway ECU and other ECUs are connected to the
main wire by the branch wire through the junction
connector(s). The wire harness is a twisted twin wire
covered with insulation. One wire (CANL) is 1.5 to 2.5
volts and the other wire (CANH) is 2.5 to 3.5 volts.
MP–7
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
Gateway ECU
Terminator
(120 ǡ)
Master ECU (ECM)
ECU
ECU
Junction Connector
ECU
ECU
Junction Connector
Terminator
(120 ǡ)
Master ECU
(Battery ECU)
B133174E02
MP
MP–8
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
• Use this procedure to troubleshoot the multiplex
communication system.
• *: Use the intelligent tester.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
CHECK BATTERY VOLTAGE
Standard voltage:
11 V or higher
If the voltage is below 11 V, recharge or replace the battery
before proceeding.
NEXT
3
CHECK DTC OF CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
(a) Using the intelligent tester, check if the CAN is
functioning normally.
Result:
Result
Proceed to
CAN DTC is not output
A
CAN DTC is output
B
B
Go to CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
A
4
CHECK FOR DTC*
(a) Check for DTCs and note any codes that are output (see
page MP-16).
(b) Delete the DTC.
(c) Recheck for DTCs. Try to prompt the DTC by simulating
the original activity that the DTC suggests.
Result:
MP
Result
Proceed to
DTC does not reoccur
A
DTC reoccurs
B
B
A
Go to step 6
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
5
MP–9
OVERALL ANALYSIS AND TROUBLESHOOTING
(a) Terminals of ECU (see page MP-9).
NEXT
6
ADJUST, REPAIR OR REPLACE
NEXT
7
CONFIRMATION TEST
NEXT
END
MP
MP–10
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
CHECK GATEWAY ECU
G1
B126164E01
(a) Disconnect the G1 connector.
(b) Measure the voltage and resistance of the wire
harness side connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
BATT (G1-10) - Body
ground
Y - Body ground
+B (BATT) power supply
Always
10 to 14 V
IG (G1-1) - Body ground
B - Body ground
Ignition power supply
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
ACC (G1-2) - Body ground
P - Body ground
ACC power supply
Power switch ON (ACC)
10 to 14 V
SIL (G1-7) - Body ground
W - Body ground
Bus "+" line
During transmission
Pulse generation
MPD2 (G1-12) - Body
ground
GR - Body ground
BEAN line
Always
10 kΩ or higher
MPD1 (G1-3) - Body
ground
GR - Body ground
BEAN line
Always
10 kΩ or higher
GTX+ (G1-6) - Body
ground
B - Body ground
AVC-LAN line
Always
10 kΩ or higher
GTX- (G1-21) - Body
ground
W - Body ground
AVC-LAN line
Always
10 kΩ or higher
GND (G1-24) - Body
ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
2.
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
CHECK A/C ECU
A8
MP
B133133E01
(a) Disconnect the A8 connector.
(b) Measure the voltage and resistance of the wire
harness side connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
+B (A8-6) - Body ground
Y - Body ground
+B power supply
Always
10 to 14 V
MPX+ (A8-3) - Body
ground
B - Body ground
BEAN line
Always
10 kΩ or higher
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
MP–11
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
MPX2+ (A8-11) - Body
ground
GR - Body ground
BEAN line
Always
10 kΩ or higher
GND (A8-1) - Body ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
MP
MP–12
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
3.
Vehicle Rear Side
CHECK DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK (MAIN
BODY ECU)
Vehicle Front Side
1G
B5
1A
1E
Main Body ECU
1A
1E
1G
B5
MP
B126166E02
(a) Disconnect the B5 ECU connector.
(b) Disconnect the 1A, 1E and 1G junction block
connectors.
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
MP–13
(c) Measure the voltage and resistance of the wire
harness side connectors.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
ECUB (1A-30) - Body
ground
R - Body ground
+B (ECUB) power supply
Always
10 to 14 V
MPX1 (1G-9) - Body
ground
GR - Body ground
BEAN line
Always
10 kΩ or higher
MPX2 (B5-15) - Body
ground
B - Body ground
BEAN line
Always
10 kΩ or higher
GND (1E-17) - Body
ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
4.
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
CHECK TRANSPONDER KEY ECU
T5
9 8 7 6
5 4 3 2 1
24 23 22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10
B126056E01
(a) Disconnect the T5 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the voltage and resistance of the wire
harness side connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
IG (T5-4) - Body ground
O - Body ground
+B (IG) power supply
Always
10 to 14 V
MPX1 (T5-17) - Body
ground
B - Body ground
BEAN line
Always
10 kΩ or higher
MPX2 (T5-16) - Body
ground
GR - Body ground
BEAN line
Always
10 kΩ or higher
GND (T5-22) - Body
ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
MP
MP–14
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
5.
CHECK TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU
T4
B126167E01
(a) Disconnect the T4 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the voltage and resistance of the wire
harness side connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
+B (T4-1) - Body ground
L - Body ground
MPX1 (T4-19) - Body
ground
GR - Body ground
+B power supply
Always
10 to 14 V
BEAN line
Always
10 kΩ or higher
MPX2 (T4-18) - Body
ground
B - Body ground
BEAN line
Always
10 kΩ or higher
E1 (T4-15) - Body ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
6.
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
CHECK CERTIFICATION ECU (WITH SMART KEY)
S11
17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10
9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18
B126057E01
(a) Disconnect the S11 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the voltage and resistance of the wire
harness side connector.
MP
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
+B1 (S11-1) - Body
ground
R - Body ground
+B power supply
Always
10 to 14 V
MPX1 (S11-31) - Body
ground
GR - Body ground
BEAN line
Always
10 kΩ or higher
MPX2 (S11-32) - Body
ground
B - Body ground
BEAN line
Always
10 kΩ or higher
E (S11-17) - Body ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
7.
MP–15
CHECK COMBINATION METER
C10
B126168E01
(a) Disconnect the C10 meter connector.
(b) Measure the voltage and resistance of the wire
harness side connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
+B (C10-21) - Body
ground
Y - Body ground
+B power supply
Always
10 to 14 V
MPX+ (C10-24) - Body
ground
B - Body ground
BEAN line
Always
10 kΩ or higher
MPX- (C10-25) - Body
ground
GR - Body ground
BEAN line
Always
10 kΩ or higher
SE (C10-14) - Body
ground
BR - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
8.
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
CHECK POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU
P6
17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10
9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
40 39 38 37 36 35 34 33 32 31 30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21 20 19 18
B126057E02
(a) Disconnect the P6 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the voltage and resistance of the wire
harness side connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
AM1 (P6-33) - Body
ground
R - Body ground
+B (AM1) power supply
Always
10 to 14 V
MPX1 (P6-7) - Body
ground
GR - Body ground
BEAN line
Always
10 kΩ or higher
MPX2 (P6-24) - Body
ground
B - Body ground
BEAN line
Always
10 kΩ or higher
GND2 (P6-6) - Body
ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
MP
MP–16
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
9.
CHECK TIRE PRESSURE MONITOR ECU
T11
C107243E03
(a) Disconnect the T11 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
IG (T11-1) - Body ground
B - Body ground
Power supply
Always
10 to 14 V
MPX1 (T11-6) - Body
ground
W - Body ground
BEAN line
Always
10 kΩ or higher
MPX2 (T11-12) - Body
ground
B - Body ground
BEAN line
Always
10 kΩ or higher
GND (T11-7) - Body
ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
MP
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
MP–17
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
1.
DESCRIPTION
The gateway ECU sets a diagnosis trouble code (DTC) if
a malfunction occurs in the multiplex communication
network (MPX). The intelligent tester allows the DTC to
be displayed when the tester is connected to the DLC3.
2.
DLC3
The vehicle's ECU uses the ISO 15765-4 communication
protocol. The terminal arrangement of the DLC3
complies with ISO 15031-3 and matches the ISO 157654 format.
CG SG CANH SIL
CANL
BAT
H100769E22
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified condition
SIL (7) - SG (5)
Bus "+" line
During transmission
Pulse generation
CG (4) - Body ground
Chassis ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
SG (5) - Body ground
Signal ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
BAT (16) - Body ground
Battery positive
Always
11 to 14 V
CANH (6) - CANL (14)
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Power switch OFF
54 to 69 Ω
CANH (6) - Body ground
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or higher
CANH (6) - CG (4)
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Power switch OFF
1 kΩ or higher
CANL (14) - Body ground
LOW-level CAN bus line
Power switch OFF
1 MΩ or higher
CANL (14) - CG (4)
LOW-level CAN bus line
Power switch OFF
1 kΩ or higher
If the result is not as specified, the DLC3 may have a
malfunction. Repair or replace the harness and
connector.
HINT:
Connect the cable of the intelligent tester (with CAN
VIM) to the DLC3, turn the power switch ON (IG) and
attempt to use the tester. If the screen displays the
message UNABLE TO CONNECT TO VEHICLE, there
is a problem either with the vehicle or the tester.
If communication is normal when the intelligent tester is
connected to another vehicle, inspect the DLC3 on the
original vehicle.
If communication is still not possible when the tester is
connected to another vehicle, the problem is probably in
the tester itself. Consult the Service Department listed in
the tester's instruction manual.
Intelligent Tester
DLC3
CAN VIM
B126098E01
MP
MP–18
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
DTC CHECK / CLEAR
Intelligent Tester
1.
2.
DLC3
CAN VIM
B126098E01
MP
CHECK DTC
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Read the DTCs by following the prompts on the
intelligent tester screen.
HINT:
Refer to the tester operator's manual for further
details.
CLEAR DTC
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Erase the DTCs by following the prompts on the
tester screen.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual for
further details.
MP–19
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
See page
B1200
MPX Body ECU Stop
- Wire harness
- Driver side junction block
MP-18
B1207
Smart ECU Stop
- Wire harness
- Certification ECU
MP-21
B1210
Power ECU Stop
- Wire harness
- Power source control ECU
MP-24
B1214
Short to B+ in Door System
Communication Bus Malfunction
- Wire harness and connector in
BEAN
- A/C ECU
- Certification ECU*
- Combination meter
- Driver side junction block
- Gateway ECU
- Power source control ECU
- Tire pressure monitor ECU
- Transmission control ECU
- Transponder key ECU
MP-27
B1215
Short to GND in Door System
Communication Bus Malfunction
- Wire harness and connector in
BEAN
- A/C ECU
- Certification ECU*
- Combination meter
- Driver side junction block
- Gateway ECU
- Power source control ECU
- Tire pressure monitor ECU
- Transmission control ECU
- Transponder key ECU
MP-27
B1247
Tire Pressure Monitor Receiver
Communication Stop
- Wire harness
- Tire pressure warning ECU
MP-41
B1248
AVC-LAN Communication
Impossible
- Wire harness
- Multi-display
MP-45
B1260
"P" Position Control ECU Stop
- Wire harness
- Transponder control ECU
MP-47
B1262
A/C ECU Communication Stop
- Wire harness
- A/C ECU
MP-51
B1271
Combination Meter ECU
Communication Stop
- Wire harness
- Combination meter
MP-54
B1294
Immobiliser ECU Communication
Stop
- Wire harness
- Transponder key ECU
MP-57
HINT:
*: Equipped on smart key vehicles.
MP
MP–20
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
DTC
B1200
MPX Body ECU Stop
DESCRIPTION
This DTC is detected when communication between the main body ECU and gateway ECU stops for
more than 10 seconds.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1200
Body ECU communication stops
•
•
Driver side junction block
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
Transponder Key ECU
Driver Side Junction Block
Main Body ECU
MPX1
MPX2
A/C ECU
MPX1
MPX2+
MAIN
DOME
ECUB
GND
B126170E02
MP
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT FUSE (DOME)
(a) Remove the DOME fuse from the engine room junction
block and relay block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the fuse.
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
MP–21
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE FUSE
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK - BATTERY AND BODY
GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the 1A and 1E junction block connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance and voltage of the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
1A
1E
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1E-17 (GND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
Standard voltage
GND
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1A-30 (ECUB) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
NG
ECUB
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
B126171E01
OK
MP
MP–22
3
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK COMMUNICATION LINE
Wire Harness Side
Transponder Key ECU
Driver Side Junction Block
T5
1G
MPX1
MPX1
A/C ECU
Main Body ECU
A8
B5
MPX2+
MPX2
B126172E03
(a) Disconnect the 1G junction block connector.
(b) Disconnect the T5, A8 and B5 ECU connectors.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T5-17 (MPX1) - B5-15 (MPX2)
Below 1 Ω
A8-11 (MPX2+) - 1G-9 (MPX1)
Below 1 Ω
Result:
Result
Proceed to
Both are OK
A
One is OK
B
Both are NG
C
B
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
C
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
AND REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
MP
A
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
DTC
B1207
MP–23
Smart ECU Stop
DESCRIPTION
This DTC is detected when communication between the certification ECU and gateway ECU stops for
more than 10 seconds.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1207
Certification ECU communication
•
•
Certification ECU
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
Transmission Control ECU
Certification ECU
MPX1
MPX1
Tire Pressure Monitor ECU
MPX1
MPX2
MAIN
DOME
+B1
E
B126173E01
MP
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK OPERATION
(a) With the key in your possession, push the lock button on
the door outside handle (entry lock operation). Check
that the key warning light illuminates or starts blinking.
MP–24
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
With the key in your possession, touch the inside of the
door outside handle (entry unlock operation). Check that
the key warning light illuminates or starts blinking.
OK:
Key warning light illuminates or starts blinking.
OK
Go to step 3
NG
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (CERTIFICATION ECU - BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the S11 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance and voltage of the wire harness
side connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
S11
+B1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S11-17 (E) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
E
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S11-1 (+B1) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
B127139E01
OK
3
CHECK RESISTANCE OF COMMUNICATION LINE
Wire Harness Side
Certification ECU
S11
Transmission Control ECU
T4
Tire Pressure Monitor ECU
T11
MP
MPX1
MPX2
MPX1
MPX1
B130304E02
(a) Disconnect the S11, T4 and T11 ECU connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
MP–25
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S11-31 (MPX1) - T4-19 (MPX1)
Below 1 Ω
S11-32 (MPX2) - T11-6 (MPX1)
Below 1 Ω
Result:
Result
Proceed to
Both are OK
A
One is OK
B
Both are NG
C
B
REPLACE CERTIFICATION ECU AND
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
C
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
A
REPLACE CERTIFICATION ECU
MP
MP–26
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
DTC
B1210
Power ECU Stop
DESCRIPTION
This DTC is detected when communication between the power source control ECU and gateway ECU
stops for more than 10 seconds.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1210
Power source control communication stops
•
•
Power source control ECU
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
Combination Meter
Power Source Control ECU
MPX-
MPX1
Gateway ECU
MPX2
MPD1
IG
from
IG1 Relay
from
Battery
AM1
AM2
GND2
B126176E02
MP
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK OPERATION
(a) Without depressing the brake pedal, push the power
switch repeatedly. Check that the power mode changes
between OFF, ON (ACC) and ON (IG) alternately.
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
MP–27
OK:
Key warning light illuminates or starts blinking
according to power modes.
OK
Go to step 3
NG
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU - BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the P6 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance and voltage of the wire harness
side connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
P6
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40
AM2
Specified Condition
P6-6 (GND2) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
Standard voltage
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
GND2
Tester Connection
AM1
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
P6-33 (AM1) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
P6-32 (AM2) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
B127139E02
OK
3
CHECK RESISTANCE OF COMMUNICATION LINE
Wire Harness Side
Power Source Control ECU
Gateway ECU
Combination Meter
P6
G1
C10
MPX1
MPX2
MPD1
MPX-
MP
B126177E01
(a) Disconnect the P6 and G1 ECU connectors.
(b) Disconnect the C10 meter connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
MP–28
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
P6-7 (MPX1) - C10-25 (MPX-)
Below 1 Ω
P6-24 (MPX2) - G1-3 (MPD1)
Below 1 Ω
Result:
Result
Proceed to
Both are OK
A
One is OK
B
Both are NG
C
B
REPLACE POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU
AND REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
C
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
A
REPLACE POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU
MP
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
MP–29
DTC
B1214
Short to B+ in Door System Communication
Bus Malfunction
DTC
B1215
Short to GND in Door System Communication
Bus Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The air conditioning (A/C) ECU, body ECU (built into driver side junction block), combination meter,
certification ECU*, power source control ECU, tire pressure monitor ECU, transmission control ECU,
transponder key ECU and gateway ECU are connected to the Body Electronics Area Network (BEAN).
The gateway ECU monitors the BEAN. If there is a B+ or GND short in the BEAN, the gateway ECU sets
the DTC and the related system(s) do not operate.
DTC
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1214
B+ short in BEAN
B1215
GND short in BEAN
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
A/C ECU
Certification ECU*
Combination meter
Driver side junction block
Gateway ECU
Power source control ECU
Tire pressure monitor ECU
Transmission control ECU
Transponder key ECU
Wire harness and connector in BEAN
HINT:
*: Equipped on smart key vehicles.
MP
MP–30
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Gateway ECU
Combination Meter
Power Source Control ECU
MPD1
Certification ECU*1
Tire Pressure Monitor ECU
Transmission Control ECU
*2
Transponder Key ECU
A/C ECU
Driver Side Junction Block
MP
MPD2
*1: w/ Smart Key System
*2: w/o Smart Key System
E116661E10
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
MP–31
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK A/C ECU
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
Wire Harness Side
A8
Turn the power switch OFF.
Disconnect the A/C ECU connector.
Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Clear and check DTCs.
Result
DTC
Conclusion
Proceed to
B1214 or B1215 is
present
A/C ECU is OK
A
B1214 and B1215 are not
present
A/C ECU is
malfunctioning
B
B
REPLACE A/C ECU
B126184E01
A
2
CHECK TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
(e)
Wire Harness Side
T4
Turn the power switch OFF .
Connect the A/C ECU connector.
Disconnect the transmission control ECU connector.
Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Clear and check DTCs.
Result
DTC
Conclusion
Proceed to
B1214 or B1215 is
present
Transmission control
ECU is OK
A
B1214 and B1215 are not
present
Transmission control
ECU is malfunctioning
B
B
REPLACE TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU
B126181E01
A
MP
MP–32
3
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU - A/C ECU)
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the transmission control ECU connector and
A/C ECU connector.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Clear and check DTCs.
Result
Wire Harness Side
A/C ECU
A8
DTC
Conclusion
Proceed to
B1214 or B1215 is
present
Wire harness is OK
A
B1214 and B1215 are not
present
Wire harness is short
circuited
B
B
Go to step 8
Transmission Control ECU
T4
B127147E02
A
4
CHECK POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Connect the A/C ECU connector and transmission
control ECU connector.
(c) Disconnect the power source control ECU connector.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(e) Clear and check DTCs.
Result
Wire Harness Side
P6
MP
DTC
Conclusion
Proceed to
B1214 or B1215 is
present
Power source control
ECU is OK
A
B1214 and B1215 are not
present
Power source control
ECU is malfunctioning
B
B
E116654E10
A
REPLACE POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
5
MP–33
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU - TRANSMISSION CONTROL
ECU)
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the power source control ECU connector and
transmission control ECU connector.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Clear and check DTCs.
Result
Wire Harness Side
Power Source Control ECU
P6
DTC
Conclusion
Proceed to
B1214 or B1215 is
present
Wire harness is OK
A
B1214 and B1215 are not
present
Wire harness is short
circuited
B
B
Go to step 12
Transmission Control ECU
T4
B127148E01
A
MP
MP–34
6
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (GATEWAY ECU - POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU)
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Connect the transmission control ECU connector.
(c) Disconnect the power source control ECU connector and
gateway ECU connector.
(d) Measure the resistance and voltage of the gateway ECU
connector terminal.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Gateway ECU
G1
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
G1-3 (MPD1) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
Standard voltage
MPD1
Power Source Control ECU
MPX2
B127150E02
MP
Condition
Specified Condition
G1-3 (MPD1) - Body
ground
Power switch ON (IG)
Below 1 V
NG
P6
OK
Tester Connection
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
7
MP–35
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (GATEWAY ECU - A/C ECU)
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Connect the power source control ECU connector.
(c) Disconnect the A/C ECU connector and gateway ECU
connector.
(d) Measure the resistance and voltage of the gateway ECU
connector terminal.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Gateway ECU
G1
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
G1-12 (MPD2) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
Standard voltage
MPD2
A/C ECU
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
G1-12 (MPD2) - Body
ground
Power switch ON (IG)
Below 1 V
NG
A8
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
MPX+
B127149E02
OK
REPLACE GATEWAY ECU
MP
MP–36
8
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Connect the A/C ECU connector and transmission
control ECU connector.
(c) Disconnect the 1G driver side junction block connector
and B5 main body ECU connector.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(e) Clear and check DTCs.
Result
Wire Harness Side
Driver Side Junction Block
1G
B5
B127151E02
MP
Conclusion
Proceed to
B1214 or B1215 is
present
Driver side junction block
is OK
A
B1214 and B1215 are not
present
Driver side junction block
is malfunctioning
B
B
Main Body ECU
A
DTC
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
9
MP–37
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK - A/C ECU)
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Connect the B5 ECU connector.
(c) Disconnect the 1G driver side junction block connector
and A/C ECU connector.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(e) Clear and check DTCs.
Result
Wire Harness Side
A/C ECU
A8
DTC
Conclusion
Proceed to
B1214 or B1215 is
present
Wire harness is OK
A
B1214 and B1215 are not
present
Wire harness is short
circuited
B
B
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
Driver Side Junction Block
1G
B127152E03
A
10
CHECK TRANSPONDER KEY ECU
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Connect the driver side junction block connector and A/C
ECU connector.
(c) Disconnect the transponder key ECU connector.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(e) Clear and check DTCs.
Result
Wire Harness Side
T5
DTC
Conclusion
Proceed to
B1214 or B1215 is
present
Transponder key ECU is
OK
A
B1214 and B1215 are not
present
Transponder key ECU is
malfunctioning
B
B
B127153E01
A
REPLACE TRANSPONDER KEY ECU
MP
MP–38
11
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TRANSPONDER KEY ECU - DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK)
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the transponder key ECU connector and B5
ECU connector.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Clear and check DTCs.
Result
Wire Harness Side
Main Body ECU
B5
DTC
Conclusion
Proceed to
B1214 or B1215 is
present
Wire harness is OK
A
B1214 and B1215 are not
present
Wire harness is short
circuited
B
B
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR (TRANSPONDER KEY ECU DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK)
Transponder Key ECU
T5
B127154E02
A
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (TRANSPONDER KEY ECU TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU)
MP
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
12
MP–39
CHECK COMBINATION METER
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Connect the power source control ECU connector and
transmission control ECU connector.
(c) Disconnect the C10 meter connector.
(d) Turn the ignition switch ON (IG).
(e) Clear and check DTCs.
Result
Wire Harness Side
C10
DTC
Conclusion
Proceed to
B1214 or B1215 is
present
Combination meter is OK
A
B1214 and B1215 are not
present
Combination meter is
malfunctioning
B
B
REPLACE COMBINATION METER
B126419E02
A
13
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (COMBINATION METER - POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU)
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the C10 combination meter and power
source control ECU connector.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Clear and check DTCs.
Result
Wire Harness Side
Combination Meter
C10
DTC
Conclusion
Proceed to
B1214 or B1215 is
present
Wire harness is OK
A
B1214 and B1215 are not
present
Wire harness is short
circuited
B
B
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
Power Source Control ECU
MP
P6
B130297E02
A
MP–40
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
14
CHECK TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Connect the C10 meter connector and power source
control ECU connector.
(c) Disconnect the tire pressure monitor ECU connector.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(e) Clear and check DTCs.
Result
Wire Harness Side
T11
DTC
Conclusion
Proceed to
B1214 or B1215 is
present
Tire pressure monitor
ECU is OK
A
B1214 and B1215 are not
present
Tire pressure monitor
ECU is malfunctioning
B
B
REPLACE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU
B130300E01
A
15
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU - COMBINATION METER)
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the tire pressure monitor ECU connector and
C10 meter connector.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Clear and check DTCs.
Result
Wire Harness Side
Tire Pressure Monitor ECU
T11
DTC
Conclusion
Proceed to
B1214 or B1215 is
present
Wire harness is OK
A
B1214 and B1215 are not
present
Wire harness is short
circuited
B
B
Combination Meter
C10
MP
B130301E01
A
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
16
MP–41
CONFIRM EQUIPMENT
Equipment
Equipment
Proceed to
With smart key system
A
Without smart key system
B
B
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR (TIRE PRESSURE MONITOR
ECU - TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU)
A
17
CHECK CERTIFICATION ECU
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Connect the C10 meter connector and tire pressure
monitor ECU connector.
(c) Disconnect the certification ECU connector.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(e) Clear and check DTCs.
Result
Wire Harness Side
S11
DTC
Conclusion
Proceed to
B1214 or B1215 is
present
Certification ECU is OK
A
B1214 and B1215 are not
present
Certification ECU is
malfunctioning
B
B
REPLACE CERTIFICATION ECU
E116654E11
A
MP
MP–42
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
18
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (CERTIFICATION ECU - TIRE PRESSURE MONITOR ECU)
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the certification ECU connector and tire
pressure monitor ECU connector.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Clear and check DTCs.
Result
Wire Harness Side
Certification ECU
S11
DTC
Conclusion
Proceed to
B1214 or B1215 is
present
Wire harness is OK
A
B1214 and B1215 are not
present
Wire harness is short
circuited
B
B
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR (CERTIFICATION ECU - TIRE
PRESSURE MONITOR ECU)
Transmission Control ECU
T4
B127148E02
A
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (CERTIFICATION ECU - TRANSMISSION
CONTROL ECU)
MP
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
DTC
B1247
MP–43
Tire Pressure Monitor Receiver Communication
Stop
DESCRIPTION
This DTC is detected when the communication between the tire pressure warning ECU and gateway ECU
stops for more than 10 seconds.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1247
Tire pressure monitor receiver communication
stops
•
•
Tire pressure warning ECU
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
Tire Pressure Warning ECU
ECU-IG
from
IG
IG1 Relay
Combination Meter
MPX+
MPX1
Certification ECU*1
Transmission Control ECU*2
MPX2*1
MPX1*2
MPX2
MP
GND
*1: w/ Smart Key System
*2: w/o Smart Key System
B130306E03
MP–44
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT FUSE (ECU-IG)
(a) Remove the ECU-IG fuse from the driver side junction
block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the fuse.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE FUSE
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU - BATTERY AND BODY
GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the T11 ECU connector.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Measure the voltage and resistance of the wire harness
side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
T11
1
2
3
7
8
9 10 11 12
4
5
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
T11-1 (IG) - Body
ground
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
6
Standard resistance
IG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T11-7 (GND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
B108903E09
OK
MP
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
3
MP–45
CHECK RESISTANCE OF COMMUNICATION LINE
*2: w/o Smart Key
*1: w/ Smart Key
Wire Harness Side
Certification ECU*1
Transmission Control ECU*2
S11
T11
T4
MPX1
MPX2
Tire Pressure Warning ECU
MPX1
B130304E05
Wire Harness Side
*1: w/ Smart Key System (for Door Lock)
*2: w/o Smart Key System (for Door Lock)
Tire Pressure Warning ECU
Combination Meter
T11
C10
MPX+
MPX2
MPX1
Transmission Control ECU*2
Certification ECU*1
T4
S11
MP
MPX1
MPX2
B131912E02
(a) Disconnect the T11, S11*1 and T4*2 ECU connectors.
(b) Disconnect the C10 meter connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T11-6 (MPX1) - S11-32 (MPX2)*1
Below 1 Ω
MP–46
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T11-6 (MPX1) - T4-19 (MPX1)*2
Below 1 Ω
T11-12 (MPX2) - C10-24 (MPX+)
Below 1 Ω
HINT:
*1: w/ Smart key system (for door lock)
*2: w/o Smart key system (for door lock)
Result:
Result
Proceed to
Both are OK
A
One is OK
B
Both are NG
C
B
REPLACE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU
AND REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
C
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
A
REPLACE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU
MP
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
DTC
B1248
MP–47
AVC-LAN Communication Impossible
DESCRIPTION
This DTC is detected when communication is impossible between the multi-display and gateway ECU.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1248
AVC-LAN communication is impossible
•
•
Multi-display
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
Gateway ECU
Multi-display
GTX+
TX1+
GTX-
TX1-
B126178E01
MP
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK OPERATION
(a) Check that the radio and player switch can operate
normally.
OK:
Radio and player switch can operate normally.
MP–48
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
NG
GO TO AUDIO SYSTEM
OK
2
CHECK RESISTANCE OF COMMUNICATION LINE
Wire Harness Side
*1: w/ Television Camera
Multi-display*1
M13
TX1+
*2: w/o Television Camera
M14
TX1-
Gateway ECU
Multi-display*2
G1
TX1+
TX1-
GTX+
GTXB131788E02
(a) Disconnect the G1 ECU connector.
(b) Disconnect the M13*1 or M14*2 display connector.
(c) Measure the resistance between the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
M13-4 (TX1+)*1 - G1-6 (GTX+)
Below 1 Ω
M13-4 (TX1+)*1 - G1-6 (GTX+)
Below 1 Ω
M14-5 (TX1-)*2 - G1-21 (GTX-)
Below 1 Ω
M14-5 (TX1-)*2 - G1-21 (GTX-)
Below 1 Ω
HINT:
*1: w/ Television camera
*2: w/o Television camera
NG
OK
MP
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLAY
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
DTC
B1260
MP–49
"P" Position Control ECU Stop
DESCRIPTION
This DTC is detected when communication between the transmission control ECU and gateway ECU
stops for more than 10 seconds.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1260
Transmission control ECU communication
stops
•
•
Transponder control ECU
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
Transmission Control ECU
Certification ECU*1, Tire Pressure Monitor ECU*2
MPX1
MPX1
Transponder Key ECU
MPX2
MPX2
To IGCT Relay
(HEV Fuse)
+B
*1: With Smart Key
*2: Without Smart Key
E1
B126180E02
MP
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT FUSE (HEV)
(a) Remove the HEV fuse from the engine room junction
block.
(b) Measure the resistance.
MP–50
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE FUSE
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU - BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the T4 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance and voltage between the wire
harness side connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
T4
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T4-15 (E1) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
Standard voltage
+B
E1
MP
Condition
Specified Condition
T4-1 (+B) - Body ground
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
NG
B126181E02
OK
Tester Connection
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
3
MP–51
CHECK RESISTANCE OF COMMUNICATION LINE
Wire Harness Side
Transponder Key ECU
Transmission Control ECU
T5
T4
MPX2
MPX1
MPX2
Tire Pressure Monitor ECU*2
Certification ECU*1
S11
T11
MPX1
*1: w/ Smart Key System (for Door Lock)
MPX1
*2: w/o Smart Key System (for Door Lock)
B131880E01
(a) Disconnect the T4, T5 and S11*1 or T11*2 ECU
connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T4-18 (MPX2) - T5-16 (MPX2)
Below 1 Ω
T4-19 (MPX1) - S11-31 (MPX1)*1
Below 1 Ω
T4-19 (MPX1) - T11-6 (MPX1)*2
Below 1 Ω
HINT:
*1: w/ Smart key system (for door lock)
*2: w/o Smart key system (for door lock)
Result:
Result
Proceed to
Both are OK
A
One is OK
B
Both are NG
C
B
REPLACE TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU
AND REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
MP
MP–52
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
C
A
REPLACE TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU
MP
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
DTC
B1262
MP–53
A/C ECU Communication Stop
DESCRIPTION
This DTC is detected when communication between the A/C ECU and gateway ECU stops for more than
10 seconds.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1262
A/C ECU communication stops
•
•
A/C ECU
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
Gateway ECU
Driver Side
Junction Block
A/C ECU
MPD2
MPX+
Body ECU
MPX1
MPX2+
MAIN
DC/DC
ECU-B
+B
GND
B126183E01
MP
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK OPERATION
(a) Check that the A/C switch can operate the air conditioner
normally.
MP–54
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
OK:
A/C switch can operate the air conditioner
normally.
OK
Go to step 3
NG
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (A/C ECU - BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the A8 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance and voltage of the wire harness
side connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
A8
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A8-1 (GND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
Standard voltage
+B
GND
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A8-6 (+B) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
B126184E02
OK
3
CHECK RESISTANCE OF COMMUNICATION LINE
Wire Harness Side
A/C ECU
Gateway ECU
Driver Side Junction Block
G1
1G
A8
MPX+
MP
MPX2+
MPD2
MPX1
B126185E01
(a) Disconnect the A8 and G1 ECU connectors.
(b) Disconnect the 1G junction block connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
MP–55
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A8-3 (MPX+) - G1-12 (MPD2)
Below 1 Ω
A8-11 (MPX2+) - 1G-9 (MPX1)
Below 1 Ω
Result:
Result
Proceed to
Both are OK
A
One is OK
B
Both are NG
C
B
REPLACE A/C ECU AND REPAIR OR
REPLACE HARNESS AND CONNECTOR
C
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
A
REPLACE A/C ECU
MP
MP–56
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
DTC
B1271
Combination Meter ECU Communication Stop
DESCRIPTION
This DTC is detected when communication between the combination meter and gateway ECU stops for
more than 10 seconds.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1271
Combination meter ECU communication
stops
•
•
Combination meter
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
Power Source Control ECU
Combination Meter
MPX1
MPX-
Tire Pressure Monitor ECU
MPX+
MPX2
DOME
from Battery
B126186E03
MP
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK OPERATION
(a) Check that the indicator (READY) on the combination
meter illuminates when the hybrid vehicle control system
is operating (power switch ON (READY)).
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
MP–57
OK:
Indicator can operate properly.
OK
Go to step 3
NG
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (COMBINATION METER - BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the C10 meter connector.
(b) Measure the resistance and voltage of the wire harness
side connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
C10
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
C10-14 - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
C10-21 - Body ground
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
B126419E03
OK
3
CHECK RESISTANCE OF COMMUNICATION LINE
Wire Harness Side
Combination Meter
C10
Tire Pressure Monitor ECU
P6
T11
MPX+
MPX-
Power Source Control ECU
MPX2
MPX1
MP
B131881E01
(a) Disconnect the C10 meter connector.
(b) Disconnect the P6 and T11 ECU connectors.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
C10-24 (MPX+) - T11-12 (MPX2)
Below 1 Ω
MP–58
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
C10-25 (MPX-) - P6-7 (MPX1)
Below 1 Ω
Result:
A
REPLACE COMBINATION METER
MP
Result
Proceed to
Both are OK
A
One is OK
B
Both are NG
C
B
REPLACE COMBINATION METER AND
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
C
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
DTC
B1294
MP–59
Immobiliser ECU Communication Stop
DESCRIPTION
This DTC is detected when communication between the transponder key ECU and gateway ECU stops
for more than 10 seconds.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1294
Transponder key ECU communication stops
•
•
Transponder key ECU
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
Transmission Control ECU
Transponder Key ECU
MPX2
MPX2
Driver Side Junction Block
Main Body ECU
MPX1
MPX2
IGN
from Battery
IG
GND
B126189E02
MP
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT FUSE (IGN)
(a) Remove the IGN fuse from the driver side junction block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the fuse.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
MP–60
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
NG
REPLACE FUSE
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TRANSPONDER KEY ECU - BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the T5 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance and voltage of the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
T5
IG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T5-22 (GND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
T5-4 (IG) - Body ground
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
GND
B127153E02
OK
3
CHECK RESISTANCE OF COMMUNICATION LINE
Wire Harness Side
Transmission Control ECU
Transponder Key ECU
B5
T5
T4
MPX2
Body ECU
MPX2
MPX1
MPX2
B126190E01
MP
(a) Disconnect the T4, T5 and B5 ECU connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T5-17 (MPX1) - B5-15 (MPX2)
Below 1 Ω
T5-16 (MPX2) - T4-18 (MPX2)
Below 1 Ω
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
MP–61
Result:
Result
Proceed to
Both are OK
A
One is OK
B
Both are NG
C
B
REPLACE TRANSPONDER KEY ECU AND
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
C
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
A
REPLACE TRANSPONDER KEY ECU
MP
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–1
NAVIGATION SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
NOTICE:
When disconnecting the cable from the negative (-)
battery terminal, initialize the following systems after the
cable is reconnected.
System Name
See procedure
Power Window Control System
IN-32
NS
NS–2
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
ENGINE ROOM RELAY BLOCK, RELAY BLOCK
- BK/UP LP RELAY
- DOME FUSE
NS
B128129E03
NS–3
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
OVERHEAD JUNCTION BLOCK
- MICROPHONE
FRONT NO. 2
SPEAKER LH
STEREO COMPONENT
AMPLIFIER
FRONT NO. 1
SPEAKER LH
NAVIGATION ECU
MULTI-DISPLAY
GATEWAY ECU
NS
GPS ANTENNA
RADIO RECEIVER
DRIVER SIDE
JUNCTION BLOCK
- ACC FUSE
- ECU-IG FUSE
- ECU-B FUSE
SPIRAL CABLE
STEERING PAD
SWITCH RH
STEERING PAD SWITCH LH
E126479E02
NS–4
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
Steering Pad Switch
Stereo Component
Amplifier*2
Speakers
Air Conditioning Amplifier
Radio Receiver*2
Gateway ECU*2
NS
*3
Combination Meter
Television Camera*3
Multi-display*1
Microphone
BK/UP LP Relay
GPS Antenna
*1: Master Unit
*2: Slave Unit
*3: w/ Rear View Monitor System
BEAN
Navigation ECU*2
AVC-LAN
E126410E01
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–5
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
NAVIGATION SYSTEM OUTLINE
(a) Vehicle position tracking methods
(1) It is essential that the navigation system
correctly tracks the current vehicle position and
displays it on the map. There are 2 methods to
track the current vehicle position: autonomous
(dead reckoning) and GPS* (satellite)
navigation. Both navigation methods are used in
conjunction with each other.
HINT:
*: GPS (Global Positioning System)
NS
NS–6
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
GPS Satellite
Navigation
Location by
Autonomous
Navigation
Gyro Sensor
Location by GPS
Navigation
GPS Antenna
ECU
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Navigation ECU
GPS Antenna
NS
Receive Satellite
Radio Wave
Detect Measurement
Position
GPS Correction
Vehicle Speed Sensor
Create Current Vehicle
Position Tracking Data
Detect Vehicle
Running Distance
Detect Direction
Change
Multi-display
Gyro Sensor
Map Matching
Correction
Map Disc
Map and Current Vehicle
Position Data Processing
Navigation Screen
Map Scrolling
Map Scale Switching
E109539E03
Operation
Description
Vehicle Position Calculation
Navigation ECU calculates current vehicle position (direction and
current position) using direction deviation signal from gyro sensor and
running distance signal from vehicle speed sensor, and creates
driving route.
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–7
Operation
Description
Map Display Processing
Navigation ECU processing vehicle position data, vehicle running
track, and map data from map disc.
Map Matching
Map data from the map disc is compared to vehicle position and
running track data. Then, vehicle position is matched with nearest
road.
GPS Correction
Vehicle position is matched to position measured by GPS. Then,
measurement position data from GPS unit is compared with vehicle
position and running track data. If the position is very different, GPS
measurement position is used.
Distance Correction
Running distance signal from vehicle speed sensor includes error
caused by tire wear and slippage between tires and road surface.
Distance correction is performed to account for this. Navigation ECU
automatically offsets the running distance signal to make up for
difference between it and distance data of map. Offset is automatically
updated.
HINT:
The combination of autonomous and GPS
navigation makes it possible to display the
vehicle position even when the vehicle is in
places where the GPS radio wave cannot
receive a signal. When only autonomous
navigation is used, however, the mapping
accuracy may slightly decline.
NS
NS–8
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Navigation performed even where the
GPS radio wave does not reach.
- In a tunnel
- In an indoor parking lot
- Between tall buildings
- Under an overpass
- On a forest or tree-lined path
NS
GPS satellite
Autonomous navigation
Autonomous navigation and
GPS navigation
I100028E10
(b) Autonomous navigation
This method determines the relative vehicle position
based on the running track determined by the gyro
and vehicle speed sensors located in the navigation
ECU.
(1) Gyro sensor
Calculates the direction by detecting angular
velocity. It is located in the navigation ECU.
(2) Vehicle speed sensor
Used to calculated the vehicle running distance.
(c) GPS navigation (Satellite navigation)
This method detects the absolute vehicle position
using radio waves from a GPS satellite*.
HINT:
*: GPS satellites were launched by the U.S.
Department of Defense for military purposes.
NS–9
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Current longitude/latitude/altitude is determined using the radio wave arrival time from four satellites.
GPS
NS
I100029E05
Number of
satellites
Measurement
Description
2 or less
Measurement impossible
Vehicle position cannot be obtained because number of satellites is not enough.
3
2-dimensional measurement is
possible
Vehicle position is obtained based on current longitude and latitude (this is less
precise than 3-dimensional measurement).
4
3-dimensional measurement is
possible
Vehicle position is obtained based on current longitude, latitude and altitude.
NS–10
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
(d) Map matching
The current driving route is calculated by
autonomous navigation (according to the gyro
sensor and vehicle speed sensor) and GPS
navigation. This information is then compared with
possible road shapes from the map data in the map
disc and the vehicle position is set onto the most
appropriate road.
Start
Actual driving route
NS
Driving route on the display
(Route by estimation)
L1, L2, L3
L 1
A
L 2
Roads
L 3
The system compares the shape of the roads L1,
L2 and L3 to the estimated running track after the
vehicle makes a right turn. At point A, the vehicle
position differs enough from the shape of L1 that
the display switches to the road L2.
Map
Matching
I100030E09
NS–11
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
2.
Outer
Glass
MULTI-DISPLAY OUTLINE
(a) Touch switch
Touch switches are touch-sensitive (interactive)
switches operated by touching the screen. When a
switch is pressed, the outer glass bends in to
contact the inner glass at the pressed position. By
doing this, the voltage ratio is measured and the
pressed position is detected.
Inner
Vx1 (Vy1)
Vy1
NS
Vx2
Vx1
Vy2
Vx2 (Vy2)
The touch switch detects the voltage ratio
and calculates the position on the screen.
Touch-sensitive switch position
I100031E03
3.
DVD (DIGITAL VERSATILE DISC) PLAYER OUTLINE
(for Navigation Map)
(a) The navigation ECU uses a laser pickup to read the
digital signals recorded on a DVD.
CAUTION:
Because the navigation system uses an
invisible laser beam, do not look directly at the
laser pickup. Be sure to only operate the
navigation as instructed.
NOTICE:
• Do not disassemble any part of the navigation
ECU.
• Do not apply oil to the navigation ECU.
NS–12
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
• Do not insert anything but a DVD into the
navigation ECU.
4.
BLUETOOTH is a trademark
owned by Bluetooth SIG, Inc.
I101463E01
BLUETOOTH OUTLINE
(a) Bluetooth is a new wireless connection technology
that uses the 2.4 GHz frequency band. This makes
it possible to connect a cellular phone (Bluetooth
capable phone*) to the multi-display (Bluetooth
system is built-in), and use a handsfree function
with the cellular phone in a pocket or bag. As a
result, it is not necessary to use a connector for the
cellular phone.
HINT:
*: The communication performance of Bluetooth
may vary depending on the Bluetooth version,
obstructions or radio wave conditions between
communication devices, electromagnetic radiation,
communication device sensitivity, or antenna
capacity.
Multi-display
(Built-in Bluetooth receiver antenna)
NS
Cellular Tower
Cellular Phone (Bluetooth type)
I100033E08
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
5.
NS–13
AVC-LAN DESCRIPTION
(a) What is AVC-LAN?
AVC-LAN, an abbreviation for "Audio Visual
Communication Local Area Network", is a united
standard developed by the manufacturers in
affiliation with Toyota Motor Corporation. This
standard pertains to audio and visual signals as well
as switch and communication signals.
Example
Radio Receiver (Resistor 60 to 80 Ω)
AVC-LAN
Stereo Component Amplifier
I100032E10
(b) Purpose:
Recently, car audio systems have rapidly developed
and the functions have vastly changed. The
conventional car audio system is being integrated
with multimedia interfaces similar to those in
navigation systems. At the same time, customers
are demanding higher quality from their audio
systems. This is merely an overview of the
standardization background. The specific purposes
are as follows:
(1) To solve sound problems, etc. caused by using
components of different manufacturers thorough
signal standardization.
(2) To allow each manufacturer to concentrate on
developing products they do best. From this,
reasonably priced products can be produced.
HINT:
• If a short +B or short to ground is detected in
the AVC-LAN circuit, communication is
interrupted and the audio system will stop
functioning.
• If an audio system is equipped with a
navigation system, the multi-display unit acts
as the master unit.
If the navigation system is not equipped, the
audio head unit acts as the master unit
instead. If the multi-display is equipped, it is
the navigation ECU master unit.
NS
NS–14
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
6.
7.
NS
COMMUNICATION SYSTEM OUTLINE
(a) Components of the navigation system communicate
with each other via the AVC-LAN.
(b) Radio receiver assembly has enough resistance (60
to 80 Ω) necessary for transmitting the
communication. This is essential for
communication.
(c) If a short circuit or open circuit occurs in the AVCLAN circuit, communication is interrupted and the
navigation system will stop functioning.
DIAGNOSTIC FUNCTION OUTLINE
(a) The navigation system has a diagnostic function
(the result is indicated on the master unit).
(b) A 3-digit hexadecimal component code (physical
address) is allocated to each component on the
AVC-LAN. Using this code, the component in the
diagnostic function can be displayed.
NS–15
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
• Use these procedures to troubleshoot the navigation
system.
• *: Use intelligent tester.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
INSPECT BATTERY VOLTAGE
Standard voltage:
11 to 14 V
If the voltage is below 11 V, recharge or replace the battery
before proceeding.
NEXT
3
NS
BASIC INSPECTION
(a) Turn the power switch ON (ACC).
(b) Check whether or not the display appears on the multidisplay.
Result
Result
Proceed to
Display appears
A
Display does not appear
B
B
Go to step 7
A
4
INSPECT COMMUNICATION FUNCTION OF MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
(BEAN)*
(a) Use the intelligent tester to check if the Multiplex
Communication System (MPX) is functioning normally.
Result
Result
Proceed to
MPX DTC is not output
A
MPX DTC is output
B
B
A
Go to MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION
SYSTEM
NS–16
5
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Check for DTCs and note any codes that are output.
(b) Delete for DTC.
(c) Recheck for DTCs. Based on the DTC output in the first
step, try to force output of the audio system DTC by
simulating the operation indicated by the DTC.
HINT:
• If the system cannot enter the diagnosis mode,
inspect each AVC-LAN communication signal and
repair or replace problem parts.
• Even if the malfunction symptom is not confirmed,
check for DTCs. This is because the system stores
past DTCs.
• Refer to the detailed description on the diagnostic
screen, as necessary (see page NS-27).
• Check and clear past diagnostic trouble codes. Check
the diagnostic trouble code and inspect the area the
code indicates.
Result
Result
NS
Proceed to
DTC does not reoccur
A
DTC does not reoccurs
B
B
Go to step 8
A
6
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Result
Result
Proceed to
Fault is not listed in problem symptoms table
A
Fault is listed in problem symptoms table
B
B
Go to step 8
A
7
OVERALL ANALYSIS AND TROUBLESHOOTING
(a) Terminals of ECU (see page NS-40)
NEXT
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
8
NS–17
ADJUST, REPAIR OR REPLACE
NEXT
END
NS
NS–18
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
SYSTEM NORMAL CONDITION CHECK
1.
CHECK NORMAL CONDITION
(a) If the symptom is applicable to any of the following,
it is the intended behavior, not a malfunction.
Symptom
Answer
A longer route than expected is chosen.
Depending on the road conditions, the navigation ECU may determine
that a longer route is quicker.
Even when distance priority is high, the shortest route is not shown.
Some paths may not be advised due to safety concerns.
When the vehicle is put into motion immediately after the hybrid
system starts, the navigation system deviates from the actual position.
If the vehicle starts before the navigation system activates, the system
may not react.
When running on certain types of roads, especially new roads, the
vehicle position deviates from the actual position.
When the vehicle is driving on new roads not available on the map
disc, the system attempts to match it to another nearby road, causing
the position mark to deviate.
(b) The following symptoms are not a malfunction, but
are caused by errors inherent in the GPS, gyro
sensor, speed sensor, and navigation ECU.
(1) The current position mark may be displayed on a
nearby parallel road.
NS
I100066
(2) Immediately after a fork in the road, the current
vehicle position mark may be displayed on the
wrong road.
I100067
(3) When the vehicle turns right or left at an
intersection, the current vehicle position mark
may be displayed on a nearby parallel road.
I100068
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–19
(4) When the vehicle is carried, such as on a ferry,
and the vehicle itself is not running, the current
vehicle position mark may be displayed in the
position where the vehicle was until a
measurement can be performed by GPS.
I100069
(5) When the vehicle runs on a steep hill, the
current vehicle position mark may deviate from
the correct position.
I100070
(6) When the vehicle makes a continuous turn of
360°, 720°, 1,080°, etc., the current vehicle
position mark may deviate from the correct
position.
I100071
(7) When the vehicle moves erratically, such as
constant lane changes, the current vehicle
position mark may deviate from the correct
position.
I100072
(8) When the power switch is turned ON (ACC or
ON) on a turntable before parking, the current
vehicle position mark may not point in the
correct direction. The same will occur when the
vehicle comes out of parking.
I038146E01
NS
NS–20
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
(9) When the vehicle runs on a snowy road or a
mountain path with tire chains installed or using
a spare tire, the current vehicle position mark
may deviate from the correct position.
I100074
(10)When a tire is changed, the current vehicle
position mark may deviate from the correct
position.
HINT:
• The diameter of the tire may change, causing
a speed sensor error.
• Performing the "tire change" in calibration
mode will allow the system to correct the
current vehicle position faster.
I100075
NS
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–21
DISPLAY CHECK MODE
HINT:
• This mode checks the color display on the multi-display.
• Illustrations may differ from the actual vehicle depending
on the device settings and options. Therefore, some
detailed areas may not be exactly the same as on the
actual vehicle.
1. ENTER DIAGNOSTIC MODE (See page NS-43)
2.
DISPLAY CHECK
(a) Select "Display Check" from the "Diagnosis MENU"
screen.
3.
COLOR BAR CHECK
(a) Select "Color Bar Check" from the "Display Check"
screen.
E120055
NS
E120053E10
(b) Select a color bar from the "Color Bar Check Mode"
screen.
(c) Check the display color.
HINT:
• The entire screen turns to the color or stripe
selected.
• Touch the display to return to the "Color Bar
Check" screen.
E120102
NS–22
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
4.
TOUCH SWITCH CHECK
(a) Select "Touch Switch Check" from the "Display
Check" screen.
E120053E11
(b) Touch the display anywhere in the open area to
perform the check when the "Touch Switch Check"
screen is displayed.
HINT:
A "+" mark is displayed on the display is touched.
E120103
5.
NS
PANEL SWITCH CHECK
(a) Select "Panel Switch Check" from the "Display
Check" screen.
E120053E14
(b) Operate each switch and check that the switch
name and condition are correctly displayed.
*
E126438E01
Display
Contents
Push switch name/*
•
•
Name of the pressed switch is displayed.
If more than one switch is pressed, "MULTIPLE" is displayed.
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
6.
NS–23
VEHICLE SIGNAL CHECK
(a) Select "Vehicle Signal Check" from the "Display
Check" screen.
E120053E12
(b) When the "Vehicle Signal Check Mode" screen is
displayed, check all the vehicle signal conditions.
HINT:
• Only conditions having inputs are displayed.
• This screen is updated once per second when
input signals to the vehicle are changed.
• For details of this function, refer to DIAGNOSIS
DISPLAY DETAILED DESCRIPTION (see page
NS-27).
I038223
7.
MIC & VOICE RECOGNITION CHECK
(a) Select "Mic & Voice Recognition Check" on the
"Display Check" screen to display "MICROPHONE
& VOICE RECOGNITION CHECK" screen.
E120053E13
Microphone Input Level Meter
Recording
Switch
Stop
Switch
Recording
Play
Switch Indicator
E125811E01
(b) When a voice is input into the microphone, check
that the microphone input level meter changes
according to the input voice.
(c) Push the recording switch and perform voice
recording.
(d) Check that the recording indicator remains on while
recording and that the recorded voice is played
normally.
HINT:
For details of this function, refer to DIAGNOSIS
DISPLAY DETAILED DESCRIPTION (see page NS27).
NS
NS–24
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
BLUETOOTH TEL CHECK MODE
HINT:
Illustrations may differ from the actual vehicle depending on
the device settings and options. Therefore, some detailed
area may not be shown the same as on the actual vehicle.
1. ENTER DIAGNOSTIC MODE (see page NS-43)
2.
BLUETOOTH TEL CHECK
(a) Select "Bluetooth TEL Check" from the "Diagnosis
MENU" screen.
3.
BLUETOOTH CHECK
(a) Select "Bluetooth Check" from the "Bluetooth
Handsfree Check Menu" screen.
E120062
NS
E120063
(b) Select "Serial Communication Log" from the
"Bluetooth Check Menu" screen
E120064
(1) The communication log data in the multi-display
are displayed on this screen.
HINT:
The displayed data can be used as a reference.
E120065
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–25
(c) Select "Software Version" from the "Bluetooth
Check Menu" screen.
E120066
(1) Check the software version of the Bluetooth
module.
*1
*2
*3
*4
E120067E02
Screen description:
Display
Contents
General Version/*1
•
•
API Version/*2
API software version is displayed.
Upper Stack Version/*3
Upper Stack version is displayed.
Lower Stack Version/*4
Lower Stack version is displayed.
Overalll software version of Bluetooth module
If any of the API version, upper stack version, and low stack
version is updated, the general version is upgraded.
HINT:
This function is controlled by the multi-display.
4.
E120068
HANDSFREE VOICE QUALITY SET
(a) Select "Handsfree Voice Quality Set" from the
"Bluetooth Handsfree Check Menu" screen.
NS
NS–26
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
(b) Check the handsfree voice level.
*1
*2
E120069E01
Screen description:
Display
Contents
Received voice level adjustment/*1
Setting possible for the voice level received from Bluetooth compatible
phones.
Sent voice level adjustment/*2
Setting possible for the voice sent to Bluetooth compatible phones.
HINT:
This function is controlled by the multi-display.
NOTICE:
"Voice Quality Type" should not be changed.
NS
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–27
NAVIGATION CHECK MODE
HINT:
• This mode displays GPS satellite information.
• Illustrations may differ from the actual vehicle depending
on the device settings and options. Therefore, some
detailed areas may not be shown the same as on the
actual vehicle.
1. ENTER DIAGNOSTIC MODE (see page NS-43 )
2.
NAVIGATION CHECK
(a) Select "Navigation Check" from the "Diagnosis
MENU" screen.
3.
GPS INFORMATION
(a) Select "GPS Information" from the "Navigation
Check" screen.
E120058
NS
E120059E08
(b) When GPS information is displayed, check the GPS
conditions.
HINT:
• This screen is updated once per second when
input signals to the vehicle are changed.
• For details of this function, refer to DIAGNOSIS
DISPLAY DETAILED DESCRIPTION (see page
NS-27).
I102403
4.
E120059E09
VEHICLE SENSORS
(a) Select "Vehicle Sensors" from the "Navigation
Check" screen.
NS–28
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
(b) Check all the signals and sensors when vehicle
signal information is displayed.
HINT:
• This screen is updated once per second when
input signals to the vehicle are changed.
• This screen displays vehicle signals input to the
navigation ECU.
• For details of this function, refer to DIAGNOSIS
DISPLAY DETAILED DESCRIPTION (see page
NS-27).
E120060
5.
COLOR BAR CHECK
(a) Select "Color Bar Check" from the "Navigation
Check" screen.
E120059E10
(b) Check each color of the color bar when the "NAVI
Color Bar Check" screen is displayed.
HINT:
• Colors will not be displayed full-screen as in
"Display Check Mode".
• This screen displays the navigation ECU display
color.
NS
I100050
6.
MEMORY COPY/PASTE CHECK
HINT:
This function cannot be used.
7.
PARTS INFORMATION
(a) Select "Parts Information" from the "Navigation
Check" screen.
E120059E11
E120059E12
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–29
(b) Check the navigation and disc information when the
"Parts Information" screen is displayed.
*1
*2
*3
*4
I100052E02
Screen description:
Display
Contents
Navigation Manufacturer/*1
Navigation ECU manufacturer is displayed.
Navigation Version/*2
Navigation ECU version is displayed.
Disc Manufacturer/*3
Map disc manufacturer is displayed.
Disc Version/*4
Map disc version is displayed.
8.
MIC & VOICE RECOGNITION CHECK
(a) Select "Mic & Voice Recognition Check" on the
"Display Check" screen to display "MICROPHONE
& VOICE RECOGNITION CHECK" screen.
NS
E120059E13
Microphone Input Level Meter
Recording
Switch
Play Switch
Stop Switch
Recording
Indicator
E125118E01
(b) When a voice is input into the microphone, check
that the microphone input level meter changes
according to the input voice.
(c) Push the recording switch and perform voice
recording.
(d) Check that the recording indicator remains on while
recording and that the recorded voice is played
normally.
HINT:
• For details of this function, refer to DIAGNOSIS
DISPLAY DETAILED DESCRIPTION (see page
NS-27).
• This function is controlled by the built-in
navigation ECU.
NS–30
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
9.
DVD PLAYER INFORMATION CHECK
(a) Select "DVD Player Information" from the
"Navigation Check" screen.
E120059E14
(b) Check for DTCs.
HINT:
• This is a DVD player check function in the
navigation ECU.
• For details of this function, refer to DIAGNOSIS
DISPLAY DETAILED DESCRIPTION (see page
NS-27).
Trouble code
NS
E120061E01
NS–31
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DIAGNOSIS DISPLAY DETAILED
DESCRIPTION
HINT:
• This section contains a detailed description of displays
within diagnostic mode.
• Illustrations may differ from the actual vehicle depending
on the device settings and options. Therefore, some
detailed areas may not be exactly the same as on the
actual vehicle.
1. SYSTEM CHECK
(a) System Check Mode Screen
NS
*1
*2
*3
*1
*4
*2
I100055E08
(1) Device Names and Hardware Address/*1
HINT:
• Registered device names are displayed.
• If a device name is unknown to the system,
its physical address is shown instead.
Address No.
Name
Address No.
Name
110
EMV
120
AVX
128
1DIN TV
140
AVN
144
G-BOOK
178
NAVI
17C
MONET
190
AUDIO H/U
1AC
CAMERA-C
1B0
Rr-TV
1C0
Rr-CONT
19D
BT-HF
1C4
PANEL
1C6
G/W
1C8
FM-M-LCD
1D8
CONT-SW
1EC
Body
118
EMVN
1F1
XM
1F2
SIRIUS
230
TV-TUNER
240
CD-CH2
250
DVD-CH
280
CAMERA
360
CD-CH1
3A0
MD-CH
NS–32
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Address No.
Name
Address No.
Name
17D
TEL
440
DSP-AMP
530
ETC
1F6
RSE
1A0
DVD-P
1D6
CLOCK
238
DTV
480
AMP
(2) Check Result/*2
HINT:
Result codes for all devices are displayed.
NS
Result
Meaning
Action
OK
Device did not respond with DTC (excluding
communication DTCs from AVC-LAN).
-
EXCH
Device responds with "replace" type DTC.
Look up DTC in "Unit Check Mode" and
replace device.
CHEK
Device responds with "check" type DTC.
Look up DTC in "Unit Check Mode".
NCON
Device was previously present, but does not
respond in diagnostic mode.
1. Check power supply wire harness of
device.
2. Check AVC-LAN of device.
Old
Device responds with "old" type DTC.
Look up DTC in "Unit Check Mode".
NRES
Device responds in diagnostic mode, but
gives no DTC information.
1. Check power supply wire harness of
device.
2. Check AVC-LAN of device.
(3) Code Clear/*3
• Present DTCs are cleared.
• Press the "Code CLR" switch for 3 seconds.
(4) Memory Clear/*4
• Present and past DTCs and registered
connected device names are cleared.
• Press the "Memory CLR" switch for 3
seconds.
(b) Diagnosis MENU Screen
E120070
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–33
HINT:
Each item is grayed out or not displayed based on
the device settings.
(c) Unit Check Mode Screen
*1
*6
*5
*2
*3
*4
*7
NS
E120071E02
Screen description:
Display
Contents
Device name/*1
Target device
Segment/*2
Target device logical address
DTC/*3
DTC (Diagnostic Trouble Code)
Timestamp/*4
Time and date of past DTCs are displayed (Year is displayed in 2-digit
format).
Present Code/*5
DTCs output at service check are displayed.
Past Code/*6
Diagnostic memory results and recorded DTCs are displayed.
Diagnosis Clear Switch/*7
Pushing this switch for 3 seconds clears diagnostic memory data of
target device (both response to diagnostic system check result and
displayed data is cleared).
NS–34
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
(d) LAN Monitor (Original) Screen
*
I100058E05
(1) Check Result/*
HINT:
Check results of all the devices are displayed.
NS
Result
Meaning
Action
No Err (OK)
There are no communication DTCs.
-
CHEK
Device responds with "check" type DTC.
Look up DTC in "Unit Check Mode".
NCON
Device was previously present, but does not
respond in diagnostic mode.
1. Check power supply wire harness of
device.
2. Check AVC-LAN of device.
Old
Device responded with "old" type DTC.
Look up DTC in "Unit Check Mode".
NRES
Device responds in diagnostic mode, but
gives no DTC information.
1. Check power supply wire harness of
device.
2. Check AVC-LAN of device.
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–35
(e) LAN Monitor (Individual) Screen
*1
*2
*3
*4
*5
*7
*6
E120072E01
Screen description:
Display
Contents
Device name/*1
Target device
Segment/*2
Target logical address
DTC/*3
DTC (Diagnostic Trouble Code)
Sub-code (device address)/*4
Physical address stored with DTC (If there is no address, nothing is
displayed).
Connection check No./*5
Connection check number stored with DTC
DTC occurrence/*6
Number of times same DTC has been recorded
Diagnosis Clear Switch/*7
Pushing this switch for 3 seconds clears diagnostic memory data of
target device (both response to diagnostic system check result and
displayed data is cleared).
NS
NS–36
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
2.
DISPLAY CHECK
(a) Vehicle Signal Check Mode Screen
I100060
NS
Screen description:
Name
Contents
Battery
Battery voltage is displayed.
PKB
Parking brake ON / OFF state is displayed.
REV
Reverse signal ON / OFF state is displayed.
IG
Power switch ON / OFF state is displayed.
ADIM/TCAN
Brightness state DIM (with) / BRIGHT (without) is displayed.
TAIL
TAIL signal (Light control switch) ON / OFF state is displayed.
SPEED
Vehicle speed is displayed in km/h.
HINT:
• Only items sending a vehicle signal will be
displayed.
• This screen is updated once per second when
input signals to the vehicle are changed.
NS–37
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
(b) Microphone & Voice Recognition Check Screen
*1
*2
*3
*4
*5
E125091E01
Screen description:
Name
Contents
Microphone input level meter/*1
Monitors microphone input level every 100 ms and displays results in
8 different levels.
Recording switch/*2
Starts recording.
Stop switch/*3
Stops recording.
Play switch/*4
Plays recorded voice.
Recording indicator/*5
Comes on while recording.
HINT:
• The microphone input function is on at all times
when this screen is displayed.
• While recording or playing, the switches other
than the stop switch cannot be pushed.
• When no voice is recorded, the play switch
cannot be pushed.
• Recording will stop after 5 seconds or by pushing
the stop switch.
NS
NS–38
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
3.
NAVIGATION CHECK
(a) Navigation Check Screen
E120076E01
NS
HINT:
Each item is grayed out or not displayed based on
the device settings.
(b) GPS Information Screen
*1
*1
*2
*2
*5
*3
*4
I102405E01
(1) Satellite information/*1
Information from a maximum of 12 satellites is
displayed on the screen. This information
includes the target GPS satellite number,
elevation angle, direction, and signal level.
NS–39
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
(2) Receiving condition/*2
(DENSO model):
Display
Contents
T
System is receiving GPS signal, but is not using it for location.
P
System is using GPS signal for location.
-
System cannot receive GPS signal.
(AISIN AW model):
Display
Contents
01H
System cannot receive a GPS signal.
02H
System is tracing a satellite.
03H
System is receiving a GPS signal, but is not using it for location.
04H
System is using the GPS signal for location.
Measurement information/*3:
Display
Contents
2D
2-dimensional location method is being used.
3D
3-dimensional location method is being used.
NG
Location data cannot be used.
Error
Reception error has occurred.
-
Any other state.
Position information/*4
Display
Contents
Position
Latitude and longitude information on current position is displayed.
Date information/*5:
Display
Contents
Date
Date / time information obtained from GPS signal is displayed in
Greenwich mean time (GMT). Last 4 digits are displayed.
(c) Vehicle Sensors Screen
*1
*2
*3
E120077E01
NS
NS–40
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Vehicle signal:
Display
Contents
REV/*1
REV signal ON/OFF state is displayed.
SPD/*2
SPD signal condition is displayed.
Sensor signal:
Display
Contents
Gyro sensor/*3
Gyro sensor output condition is displayed (when vehicle runs straight
or is stationary, voltage is approximately 2.5 V).
HINT:
Signals are updated once per second only when
vehicle sensor signals are changed.
(d) Microphone & Voice Recognition Check Screen
NS
*1
*2
*3
*4
*5
E125119E01
Screen description:
Display
Contents
Microphone input level meter/*1
Monitors the microphone input level every 100 ms and displays results
in 8 different levels.
Recording switch/*2
Starts recording.
Stop switch/*3
Starts recording.
Play switch/*4
Plays recorded voice.
Recording indicator/*5
Comes on while recording.
HINT:
• The microphone input function is on at all times
when this screen is displayed.
• While recording or playing, the switches other
than the stop switch cannot be pushed.
• When no voice is recorded, the play switch
cannot be pushed.
• Recording will stop after 5 seconds or by pushing
the stop switch.
NS–41
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
(e) DVD Player Information Screen
*2
*1
*3
*4
*5
E120078E01
Screen description:
NS
Display
Contents
Trouble code/*1
Each code corresponding to malfunctions is displayed. For details,
refer to "Trouble Code Description".
Occurrence time/*2
•
•
Date (year, month, day) and time (hour, minute, second) when
trouble code was detected are displayed as time stamp
(Greenwich mean time).
Time data to be displayed are received from GPS receiver.
Trouble code clear switch/*3
All code data being displayed is cleared by pushing this switch for 3
seconds.
Returning switch/*4
Previous page is displayed. If current displayed page is first page, this
switch cannot be operated.
Proceeding switch/*5
Next page is displayed. If current displayed page is last page, this
switch cannot be operated.
Trouble code description:
Code
Malfunction
Countermeasure
01
Cannot be recognized
Replace navigation ECU.
03
Cannot be read
Follow inspection procedure for DTC 58-42 (see page
NS-80).
HINT:
This is a DVD player check function in the
navigation ECU.
NS–42
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Display function
Symptom
Pressing power switch does not turn on system.
No image appears on multi-display.
Illumination for panel switch does not come on with
TAIL switch on.
Display does not dim when light control switch is turn
on.
Power does not turn off (The screen remains on).
NS
Panel switches do not function.
Touch panel switch does not function.
Navigation screen is not displayed.
Navigation screen flicker or color distortion.
Navigation function switches can be operated while
vehicle is running.
Suspected area
See page
1. Multi-display power source circuit
NS-167
2. AVC-LAN circuit
NS-136
3. Multi-display
-
1. Proceed to "No image Appears on Multi-display"
NS-88
2. Multi-display power source circuit
NS-167
3. Illumination circuit
NS-131
4. AVC-LAN circuit
NS-136
5. Multi-display
-
1. Proceed to "Illumination for Panel Switch does not Come on
with Tail Switch ON"
NS-89
2. Illumination circuit
NS-131
3. Multi-display
-
1. Proceed to "Display does not DIM when Light Control
Switch is Turn ON"
NS-90
2. Illumination circuit
NS-131
3. Multi-display
-
1. Multi-display power source circuit
NS-167
2. Multi-display
-
1. Proceed to "Panel Switches do not Function"
NS-91
2. Steering pad switch circuit
NS-126
3. Multi-display power source circuit
NS-167
4. Multi-display
-
1. Proceed to "Touch Panel Switch does not Function"
NS-92
2. Steering pad switch circuit
NS-126
3. Multi-display power source circuit
NS-167
4. Multi-display
-
1. Display signal circuit between navigation ECU and multidisplay
NS-147
2. Map disc
-
3. Navigation ECU
-
4. Multi-display
-
1. Proceed to "Screen Flicker or Color Distortion"
NS-93
2. Display signal circuit between navigation ECU and multidisplay
NS-147
3. Navigation ECU
-
4. Multi-display
-
Vehicle speed signal circuit between multi-display and
combination meter
NS-140
Navigation function
Symptom
Map disc cannot be inserted.
Map disc cannot be ejected.
Suspected area
See page
1. Proceed to "Map Disc cannot be inserted"
NS-95
2. Navigation ECU power source circuit
NS-169
3. Navigation ECU
-
1. Proceed to "Map Disc cannot be Ejected"
NS-96
2. Navigation ECU power source circuit
NS-169
3. Navigation ECU
-
NS–43
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Symptom
Vehicle position mark deviates greatly.
Cursor or map rotates when vehicle is stopped.
Vehicle position mark is not updated.
Current position display does not appear.
GPS mark is not displayed.
Voice guidance does not function.
Map display incomplete.
Route cannot be calculated.
Voice recognition difficulty.
Voice is not recognized.
Suspected area
See page
1. Proceed to "Vehicle Position Mark Deviates Greatly"
NS-97
2. GPS antenna
-
3. Navigation ECU
-
1. Proceed to "Cursor or Map Rotates when Vehicle is
Stopped"
NS-99
2. Navigation ECU
-
1. Proceed to "Vehicle Position Mark is not Updated"
NS-100
2. Map disc
-
3. Navigation ECU
-
1. Proceed to "Current Position Display does not Appear"
NS-101
2. Map disc
-
3. GPS antenna
-
4. Navigation ECU
-
1. Proceed to "GPS Mark is not Displayed"
NS-102
2. GPS antenna
-
3. Navigation ECU
-
1. Proceed to "Voice Guidance does not Function"
NS-105
2. Navigation voice speaker circuit
NS-144
3. Map disc
-
4. Navigation ECU
-
5. Stereo component amplifier
-
1. Proceed to "Map Display Incomplete"
NS-108
2. Map disc
-
3. Navigation ECU
-
1. Proceed to "Route cannot be Calculated"
NS-109
2. Map disc
-
3. Navigation ECU
-
1. Proceed to "Voice Recognition Difficulty"
NS-112
2. Navigation ECU
-
1. Proceed to "Voice is not Recognized"
NS-114
2. Microphone circuit between overhead J/B and multi-display
NS-148
3. Microphone circuit between multi-display and navigation
ECU
NS-150
4. Steering pad switch circuit
NS-126
5. Microphone
-
6. Microphone amplifier
-
7. Navigation ECU
-
Speed signal does not change in the navigation check
mode.
Vehicle speed signal circuit between navigation ECU and
combination meter
NS-138
Reverse signal does not change in the navigation
check mode.
Reverse Signal Circuit
NS-142
Steering pad switch function
Symptom
The system cannot be operated by the steering pad
switch.
Illumination for steering pad switch does not come on
with tail switch on.
Suspected area
See page
1. Steering pad switch circuit
NS-126
2. Radio receiver
-
3. Air conditioning amplifier
-
1. Illumination circuit
NS-131
2. Radio receiver
-
3. Air conditioning amplifier
-
NS
NS–44
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Symptom
Cellular phone registration failure, phone directory
transfer failure.
Cellular phone cannot send / receive.
Cannot call in a certain place.
The other caller's voice cannot be heard, is too quiet,
or distorted.
The other caller cannot hear your voice, or your voice
is too quiet or distorted.
NS
Suspected area
See page
Proceed to "Cellular Phone Registration Failure, Phone
Directory Transfer Failure"
NS-117
1. Proceed to "Cellular phone cannot Send / Receive"
NS-119
2. Steering pad switch circuit
NS-126
3. Multi-display
-
Proceed to "Cannot call in a Certain Place"
NS-121
1. Proceed to "The Other Caller's Voice cannot be Heard, is
too Quiet, or Distorted"
NS-122
2. Multi-display
-
1. Proceed to "The Other Caller cannot hear your voice, or
Your Voice is too Quiet or Distorted"
NS-124
2. Microphone circuit between overhead J/B and multi-display
NS-148
3. Microphone
-
4. Microphone amplifier
-
5. Multi-display
-
NS–45
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
M16
M15
CHECK MULTI-DISPLAY
M13
M14
E123948E05
(a) Disconnect the M13 display connector.
(b) Measure the resistance and voltage of the wire
harness side connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
GND1 (M13-1) - Body
ground
BR - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
ACC (M13-2) - Body
ground
GR - Body ground
ACC power supply
Power switch ON (ACC)
10 to 14 V
IG (M13-10) - Body
ground
B - Body ground
IG power supply
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
+B1 (M13-3) - Body
ground
Y - Body ground
Battery power supply
Always
10 to 14 V
If the results are not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
(c) Reconnect the M13 display connector.
(d) Measure the voltage of the connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
TSW- (M14-8) - SGND
(M14-1)
BR
Shielded ground
Always
Below 1 V
SGND (M14-21) - Body
ground
Shielded - Body ground
Shielded ground
Always
Below 1 V
MCO+ (M14-22) - Body
ground
R - Body ground
Microphone voice signal
See "Microphone & Voice
Recognition Check" mode
-
MCO- (M14-23) - Body
ground
G - Body ground
Microphone voice signal
See "Microphone & Voice
Recognition Check" mode
-
TX+ (M14-9) - Body
ground
W - Body ground
AVC-LAN communication
signal
Power switch ON (ACC)
2 to 3 V
TX- (M14-10) - Body
ground
R - Body ground
AVC-LAN communication
signal
Power switch ON (ACC)
2 to 3 V
TX2+ (M13-18) - Body
ground
P - Body ground
AVC-LAN communication
signal
Power switch ON (ACC)
2 to 3 V
TX2- (M13-19) - Body
ground
W - Body ground
AVC-LAN communication
signal
Power switch ON (ACC)
2 to 3 V
TX1+ (M13-4) - Body
ground
B - Body ground
AVC-LAN communication
signal
Power switch ON (ACC)
2 to 3 V
NS
NS–46
NS
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
TX1- (M13-5) - Body
ground
W - Body ground
AVC-LAN communication
signal
Power switch ON (ACC)
2 to 3 V
TX4- (M15-6) - Body
ground
P - Body ground
AVC-LAN communication
signal
Power switch ON (ACC)
2 to 3 V
TX4+ (M15-3) - Body
ground
W - Body ground
AVC-LAN communication
signal
Power switch ON (ACC)
2 to 3 V
SLD (M14-24) - Body
ground
Shielded - Body ground
Shielded ground
Always
Below 1 V
IVO- (M14-26) - Body
ground
R - Body ground
Voice guidance signal
Voice guidance is
provided
Waveform synchronized
with sound is output
IVO+ (M14-25) - Body
ground
G - Body ground
Voice guidance signal
Voice guidance is
provided
Waveform synchronized
with sound is output
SPD (M13-20) - Body
ground
V - Body ground
Speed signal
See "Vehicle Signal
Check" mode
-
TC (M13-7) - Body ground
P - Body ground
Diagnosis ON signal
Power switch ON (IG)
9 to 14 V
DR (M13-17) - Body
ground
B - Body ground
Illumination signal
Light control switch TAIL
or HEAD
2 to 3 V
MIN+ (M14-2) - Body
ground
G - Body ground
Microphone voice signal
See "Microphone & Voice
Recognition Check" mode
-
MIN- (M14-3) - Body
ground
R - Body ground
Microphone voice signal
See "Microphone & Voice
Recognition Check" mode
-
MACC (M14-4) - Body
ground
BR - Body ground
Microphone amplifier
power supply
Power switch ON (IG)
5V
GVIF (M16-1) - Body
ground
B - Body ground
Digital image signal
Multi-display ON
Pulse generation
IVI- (M14-6) - Body ground
W - Body ground
Voice guidance signal
Voice guidance is
provided
Waveform synchronized
with sound is output
IVI+ (M14-5) - Body
ground
B - Body ground
Voice guidance signal
Voice guidance is
provided
Waveform synchronized
with sound is output
2.
If the result is not as specified, the multi-display may
have a malfunction.
CHECK NAVIGATION ECU
N4
N8
N3
E123951E03
(a) Disconnect the N3 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance and voltage of the wire
harness side connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
+B (N3-1) - Body ground
SB - Body ground
Battery power supply
Always
10 to 14 V
NS–47
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
ACC (N3-13) - Body
ground
GR - Body ground
ACC power supply
Power switch ON (ACC)
10 to 14 V
GND1 (N3-15) -Body
ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
If the results are not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
(c) Reconnect the N3 ECU connector.
(d) Measure the voltage of the connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
SPD (N3-4) - Body ground
V - Body ground
Speed signal
See "Vehicle Signal
Check" mode
-
REV (N3-20) - Body
ground
R - Body ground
Reverse signal
See "Vehicle Signal
Check" mode
-
MIC+ (N4-3) - Body
ground
R - Body ground
Microphone voice signal
See "Microphone & Voice
Recognition Check" mode
-
MIC- (N4-5) - Body ground
G - Body ground
Microphone voice signal
See "Microphone & Voice
Recognition Check" mode
-
TX- (N3-18) - Body ground
P - Body ground
AVC-LAN communication
signal
Power switch ON (ACC)
2 to 3 V
TX+ (N3-19) - Body
ground
W - Body ground
AVC-LAN communication
signal
Power switch ON (ACC)
2 to 3 V
GVIF (N8-1) - Body
ground
B - Body ground
Digital image signal
Multi-display ON
Pulse generation
SLD1 (N4-7) - Body
ground
Shielded - Body ground
Shielded ground
Always
Below 1 V
VOI- (N3-8) - Body ground
W - Body ground
Voice guidance signal
Voice guidance is
provided
Waveform synchronized
with sound is output
VOI+ (N3-9) - Body
ground
B - Body ground
Voice guidance signal
Voice guidance is
provided
Waveform synchronized
with sound is output
3.
4.
5.
6.
If the result is not as specified, the ECU may have a
malfunction.
CHECK RADIO RECEIVER (See page AV-31)
CHECK STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER (See
page AV-31)
CHECK TELEVISION CAMERA (See page PM-8) (w/
Rear View Monitor System)
CHECK GATEWAY ECU (See page AV-31)
NS
NS–48
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC CHECK / CLEAR
HINT:
• Illustrations may differ from the actual vehicle depending
on the device settings and options. Therefore, some
detailed areas may not be exactly the same as on the
actual vehicle.
• If the system cannot enter the diagnostic mode, inspect all
AVC-LAN communication components and repair or
replace problem parts.
(see page NS-136)
• After the power switch is turned ON (IG), check that the
map is displayed before starting the diagnostic mode.
Otherwise, some items cannot be checked.
1. START DIAGNOSTIC MODE
(a) There are 2 methods to start diagnostic mode. Start
the mode by using one of them.
(b) Method 1
(1) Start the hybrid system.
(2) While pressing and holding the "INFO" switch,
operate the light control switch: OFF → Turn ON
→ Turn OFF → Turn ON → Turn OFF → Turn
ON → Turn OFF.
(3) The diagnostic mode starts and the "System
Check Mode" screen will be displayed. Service
inspection starts automatically and the result will
be displayed.
(c) Method 2
(1) Start the hybrid system.
“INFO” Switch
NS
I039915E01
(2) Press the "DISPLAY" switch.
&+52.#;
/'07
+0(1
&'56
%.+/#6'
#7&+1
/#2
81+%'
E123969E02
2.
I102032
(3) From the display quality adjustment screen,
touch the corners of the screen in the following
order: upper left → lower left → upper left →
lower left → upper left → lower left.
(4) The diagnostic mode starts and the "System
Check Mode" screen will be displayed. Service
inspection starts automatically and the result will
be displayed.
FINISH DIAGNOSTIC MODE
(a) There are 2 methods to end diagnostic mode. Use
one of them.
(1) Turn the power switch OFF.
(2) Press and hold the "DISP" switch for 3 seconds.
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
3.
NS–49
DIAGNOSIS MENU
(a) The "Diagnosis MENU" screen will be displayed by
pressing the menu switch on the "System Check
Mode" screen.
E120083
NS
NS–50
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
4.
Diagnostic Code
NS
Logical Address
Diagnostic Code
Logical Address
E111721E05
CHECK DTC
(a) Read the system check result.
(1) If the check result is "EXCH", "CHEK" or "Old",
touch the displayed check result to view the
results on the "Unit Check Mode" screen and
record them.
HINT:
• If all check results are "OK", go to the
communication DTC check.
• If a device name is not known, its physical
address is displayed.
HINT:
When proceeding to view the results of another
device, press the service switch to return to the
"System Check Mode" screen. Repeat this step.
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–51
(b) Read the communication diagnostic check result.
(1) Return to the "System Check Mode" screen, and
press the "LAN Mon" switch to enter the "LAN
Monitor" screen.
I038208E05
NS
NS–52
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
(2) If the check result is "CHEK" or "Old", touch the
displayed check result to view the results on the
individual communication diagnostic screen and
record them.
HINT:
• If all check results are "No Err", the system
judges that no DTC exists.
• The sub-code (relevant device) will be
indicated by its physical address.
• When proceeding to view the results of
another device, press the "Service" switch to
return to the original "LAN Monitor" screen.
Repeat this step.
Sub-code
NS
Diagnosis Code
Logical Address
E126491E01
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
5.
NS–53
DTC CLEAR/RECHECK
(a) Clear DTC
(1) Press the "Code CLR" switch for 3 seconds.
(2) The check results are cleared.
I038211E02
(b) Recheck
(1) Press the "Recheck" switch.
I038212E01
(2) Confirm that all diagnostic codes are "OK" when
the check results are displayed. If a code other
than "OK" is displayed, troubleshoot again.
I038213E01
(3) Press the "LAN Mon" switch to change to the
"LAN Monitor" screen.
I038213E02
(4) Confirm that all diagnostic codes are "No Err". If
a code other than "No Err" is displayed,
troubleshoot again.
I038214E01
NS
NS–54
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
DTC No.
01-21
Detection Item
Trouble Area
See page
ROM Error
Multi-display
NS-52
01-22
RAM Error
Multi-display
NS-52
01-D5
Absence of Registration Unit
1. Power source circuit of
component shown by sub-code
2. AVC-LAN circuit between multidisplay and component shown by
sub-code
3. Component shown by subcode
NS-53
01-D6
No Master
1. Multi-display power source
circuit
2. Power source circuit of
component which has stored this
code
3. AVC-LAN circuit between multidisplay and component which has
stored this code
4. Component which has stored
this code
5. Multi-display
NS-55
01-D7
Connection Check Error
1. Multi-display power source
circuit
2. Power source circuit of
component which has stored this
code
3. AVC-LAN circuit between multidisplay and component which has
stored this code
4. Component which has stored
this code
5. Multi-display
NS-55
01-D8
No Response for Connection
Check
1. Power source circuit of
component shown by sub-code
2. AVC-LAN circuit between multidisplay and component shown by
sub-code
3. Component shown by subcode
NS-53
01-D9
Last Mode Error
1. Power source circuit of
component shown by sub-code
2. AVC-LAN circuit between multidisplay and component shown by
sub-code
3. Component shown by subcode
NS-53
01-DA
No Response Against ON / OFF
Command
1. Power source circuit of
component shown by sub-code
2. AVC-LAN circuit between multidisplay and component shown by
sub-code
3. Component shown by subcode
NS-53
01-DB
Mode Status Error
1. Power source circuit of
component shown by sub-code
2. AVC-LAN circuit between multidisplay and component shown by
sub-code
3. Component shown by subcode
NS-53
NS
NS–55
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC No.
Trouble Area
See page
01-DC
Transmission Error
Detection Item
If same sub-code is recorded in
other components, check harness
for power supply and
communication system of all
components shown by code
NS-59
01-DD
Master Reset
1. Multi-display power source
circuit
2. AVC-LAN circuit between multidisplay and component which has
stored this code
3. Multi-display
4. Component which has stored
this code
NS-62
01-DE
Slave Reset
1. Power source circuit of
component shown by sub-code
2. AVC-LAN circuit between multidisplay and component shown by
sub-code
3. Component shown by subcode
NS-53
01-DF
Master Error
1. Multi-display power source
circuit
2. AVC-LAN circuit between multidisplay and component which has
stored this code
3. AVC-LAN circuit between multidisplay and radio receiver
4. Multi-display
5. Component which has stored
this code
NS-66
NS
01-E0
Registration Complete Indication
Error
-
NS-71
01-E1
Voice Processing Device ON
Error
1. Multi-display power source
circuit
2. AVC-LAN circuit between multidisplay and component which has
stored this code
3. Multi-display
4. Component which has stored
this code
NS-62
01-E2
ON / OFF Indication Parameter
Error
Multi-display
NS-72
01-E3
Registration Demand
Transmission
-
NS-71
01-E4
Multiple Frame Incomplete
-
NS-71
21-10
Panel Switch Error
Multi-display
NS-73
21-11
Touch Switch Error
Multi-display
NS-73
23-10
Panel Switch Error
Multi-display
NS-73
23-11
Touch Switch Error
Multi-display
NS-73
24-10
Panel Switch Error
Multi-display
NS-73
24-11
Touch Switch Error
Multi-display
NS-73
25-10
Panel Switch Error
Multi-display
NS-73
25-11
Touch Switch Error
Multi-display
NS-73
34-10
Error in Picture Circuit
Multi-display
NS-74
34-11
No Current in Back-light Error
Multi-display
NS-74
34-12
Excess Current in Back-light
Error
Multi-display
NS-74
57-47
Bluetooth Module Initialization
Failed
Multi-display
NS-75
58-10
Gyro Error
1. Gyro sensor
2. Navigation ECU
NS-76
NS–56
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC No.
NS
Detection Item
Trouble Area
See page
58-11
GPS Receiver Error
Navigation ECU
NS-78
58-40
GPS Antenna Error
1. Wire harness
2. GPS antenna
3. Navigation ECU
NS-79
58-41
GPS Antenna Power Source
Error
1. Wire harness
2. GPS antenna
3. Navigation ECU
NS-79
58-42
Map Disc Read Error
1. Map disc
2. Navigation ECU
NS-80
58-43
SPD Signal Error
1. Speed signal circuit
2. Navigation ECU
NS-82
58-44
Player Error
Navigation ECU
NS-83
58-45
High Temperature
Navigation ECU
NS-84
5C-40
Camera Picture Error
1. Wire harness
2. Television camera assembly
3. Multi-display
NS-85
80-10
Gyro Error
1. Gyro sensor
2. Navigation ECU
NS-76
80-11
GPS Receiver Error
Navigation ECU
NS-78
80-40
GPS Antenna Error
1. Wire harness
2. GPS antenna
3. Navigation ECU
NS-79
80-41
GPS Antenna Power Source
Error
1. Wire harness
2. GPS antenna
3. Navigation ECU
NS-79
80-42
Map Disc Read Error
1. Map disc
2. Navigation ECU
NS-80
80-43
SPD Signal Error
1. Speed signal circuit
2. Navigation ECU
NS-82
80-44
Player Error
Navigation ECU
NS-83
80-45
High Temperature
Navigation ECU
NS-84
NS–57
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
01-21
ROM Error
DTC
01-22
RAM Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
01-21
Malfunction exists in ROM.
01-22
Malfunction exists in RAM.
Trouble Area
Multi-display
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLAY
NEXT
END
NS
NS–58
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
01-D5
Absence of Registration Unit
DTC
01-D8
No Response for Connection Check
DTC
01-D9
Last Mode Error
DTC
01-DA
No Response Against ON / OFF Command
DTC
01-DB
Mode Status Error
DTC
01-DE
Slave Reset
DESCRIPTION
NS
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
01-D5*1, *3
When either condition below is met:
• Component shown by sub-code is (was)
disconnected from system when turning power
switch on (ACC or IG).
• Communication condition with device that code
shows cannot be obtained when hybrid system
starts.
•
01-D8*2, *3
Component shown by sub-code is (was) disconnected
from system after hybrid system start.
01-D9*1, *3
Device that had functioned before the hybrid system
stopped is (was) disconnected from system when
power switch is (was) ON (IG or ACC).
01-DA*3
When either condition below is met:
• No response is identified when changing mode.
• Sound and image do not change by switch
operation.
01-DB*1, *3
Dual alarm is detected.
01-DE*3
Slave device has been disconnected after hybrid
system start.
•
•
Power source circuit of component shown by subcode
AVC-LAN circuit between multi-display and
component shown by sub-code
Component shown by sub-code
HINT:
• *1: Even if no fault is present, this trouble code may be stored depending on the battery condition or
hybrid system start voltage.
• *2: If the power connector is disconnected after the hybrid system starts, this code is stored after 180
seconds.
• *3: If it is reported that the device does not exist during verification, check the power source circuit and
AVC-LAN circuit for the device.
NOTICE:
• Before starting troubleshooting, be sure to clear DTCs to erase codes stored due to the
reasons described in the HINT above. Then, check for DTCs and troubleshoot according to the
output DTCs.
• The multi-display is the master unit.
• Be sure to clear and recheck DTCs after the inspection is completed to confirm that no DTCs
are output.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
Be sure to read DESCRIPTION before performing the following procedures.
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
1
NS–59
CHECK "MULTI-DISPLAY COMMUNICATION ERROR" IN FLOWCHART
(a) Refer to the multi-display communication error (see page
NS-161).
NEXT
END
NS
NS–60
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
01-D6
No Master
DTC
01-D7
Connection Check Error
DESCRIPTION
NS
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
01-D6*1
When either of the following conditions is met:
• The component which has stored the code has
(had) been disconnected when the power switch is
ON (ACC or IG).
• The master device has (had) been disconnected
when this code is stored.
01-D7*2
When either of the following conditions is met:
• The component which has stored the code has
(had) been disconnected after the hybrid system
starts (started).
• The master device has (had) been disconnected
when this code is (was) stored.
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
•
Multi-display power source circuit
Power source circuit of the component which has
stored this code
AVC-LAN circuit between the multi-display and the
component which has stored this code
Component which has stored this code
Multi-display
HINT:
• *1: Even if no fault is present, this trouble code may be stored depending on the battery condition or
hybrid system start voltage.
• *2: When 210 seconds have elapsed after disconnecting the power supply connector of the master
component with the power switch ON (ACC or IG), this code is stored.
NOTICE:
• Before starting troubleshooting, be sure to clear DTCs to erase codes stored due to the
reasons described in the HINT above. Then, check for DTCs and troubleshoot according to the
output DTCs.
• The multi-display is the master unit.
• Be sure to clear and recheck DTCs after the inspection is completed to confirm that no DTCs
are output.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
Be sure to read DESCRIPTION before performing the following procedures.
1
CHECK MULTI-DISPLAY POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT
(a) Refer to the multi-display power source circuit (see page
NS-167).
If the power source circuit is operating normally, proceed
to the next step.
NEXT
NS–61
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
2
IDENTIFY COMPONENT WHICH HAS STORED THIS CODE
(a) Enter the diagnostic mode.
(b) Press the "LAN Mon" switch to change to "LAN Monitor"
mode.
(c) Identify the component which has stored this code.
Component table:
Example
Display
Component
AUDIO H/U
Radio receiver
DSP-AMP
Stereo component amplifier
G/W
Gateway ECU
NAVI
Navigation ECU
CAMERA
Intelligent parking assist ECU
HINT:
"NAVI" is the component which has stored this code in
the example shown in the illustration.
NS
Component which
has stored this code
DTC
E126492E01
NEXT
3
CHECK POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT OF COMPONENT WHICH HAS STORED THIS CODE
(a) Inspect the power source circuit of the component which
has stored this code.
If the power source circuit is operating normally, proceed
to the next step.
Component table:
Component
Proceed to
Radio receiver (AUDIO H/U)
Radio receiver power source circuit (see page AV-171)
Stereo component amplifier (DSP-AMP)
Stereo component amplifier power source circuit (see page AV-173)
Gateway ECU (G/W)
Gateway ECU power source circuit (see page AV-177)
Navigation ECU (NAVI)
Navigation ECU power source circuit (see page NS-169)
NS–62
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NEXT
4
INSPECT RADIO RECEIVER
(a) Disconnect the R5 and R6 receiver connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance of the receiver.
Standard resistance
Radio Receiver
Tester Connection
R5
R6-5 (TX+) - R6-15 (TX-)
60 to 80 Ω
R5-9 (TX+) - R5-10 (TX-)
60 to 80 Ω
NG
TX-
Specified Condition
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER ASSEMBLY
TX+
Radio Receiver
R6
NS
TX+
TXE126486E01
OK
5
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (MULTI-DISPLAY - COMPONENT WHICH HAS STORED THIS
CODE)
HINT:
For details of the connectors, refer to "TERMINALS OF ECU"
(see page NS-40).
(a) Referring to the AVC-LAN wiring diagram below, check
the AVC-LAN circuit between the multi-display and the
component which has stored this code.
(1) Disconnect all connectors between the multi-display
and the component which has stored this code.
(2) Check for an open or short in the AVC-LAN circuit
between the multi-display and the component which
has stored this code.
OK:
There is no open or short circuit.
NS–63
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
AVC-LAN Wiring Diagram
GTX+
TX1+
TX+
Navigation ECU
(Slave Unit)
TX4-
TX-
Multi-display
(Master Unit)
Gateway ECU
(Slave Unit)
GTX-
Stereo
Component
Amplifier
(Slave Unit)
TX4+
TX1-
TX+
TX+
TX-
TX-
TX2-
TX2+
TX-
TX+
NS
Radio Receiver
(Slave Unit)
E126411E03
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
6
REPLACE COMPONENT WHICH HAS STORED THIS CODE
(a) Replace the component which has stored this code with
a normal one and check if the same problem occurs
again.
OK:
Same problem does not occur.
NG
OK
END
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLAY
NS–64
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
01-DC
Transmission Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
01-DC
Transmission to component shown by sub-code failed.
(Detecting this DTC does not always mean actual
failure.)
Trouble Area
If same sub-code is recorded in other components,
check harness for power supply and communication
system of all components shown by code
NOTICE:
• The multi-display is the master unit.
• Be sure to clear and recheck DTCs after the inspection is completed to confirm that no DTCs
are output.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
Be sure to read DESCRIPTION before performing the following procedures.
1
CHECK FOR DTC OF OTHER COMPONENTS
(a) Check if the component shown by the sub-code is
displayed in the check result of the other components.
(1) Check if "01-DC" is output for the other
components.
(2) If "01-DC" is output for any other components,
check if the same physical address is displayed.
HINT:
For the list of the components shown by sub-codes,
refer to the table in the next step.
Result
NS
Result
Proceed to
"01-DC" is output and the same physical address is
displayed
A
"01-DC" is not output or the same physical address
is not displayed
B
B
A
Go to step 4
NS–65
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
2
IDENTIFY COMPONENT WHICH HAS STORED THIS CODE
(a) Enter the diagnostic mode.
(b) Press the "LAN Mon" switch to change to "LAN Monitor"
mode.
(c) Identify the component which has stored this code.
Component table:
Example
Display
Component
AUDIO H/U
Radio receiver
DSP-AMP
Stereo component amplifier
G/W
Gateway ECU
NAVI
Navigation ECU
EMV
Multi-display
HINT:
"NAVI" is the component which has stored this code in
the example shown in the illustration.
NS
Component which
has stored this code
DTC
Component shown by sub-code
E126492E02
NEXT
3
CHECK COMPONENT WHICH HAS STORED THIS CODE
(a) Select the component which has stored this code.
Component table:
Component
Proceed to
Gateway ECU (G/W)
Gateway ECU communication error (see page NS-152)
Radio receiver (AUDIO H/U)
Radio receiver communication error (see page NS-155)
Stereo component amplifier (DSP-AMP)
Stereo component amplifier communication error (see page NS-158)
Navigation ECU (NAVI)
Navigation ECU communication error (see page NS-164)
Multi-display (EMV)
Multi-display communication error (see page NS-161)
NS–66
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NEXT
END
4
CLEAR DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (see page NS-43).
HINT:
If "01-DC" is output for only one component, this may not
indicate a malfunction.
NEXT
5
RECHECK DTC
(a) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble occurs
again.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NG
NS
OK
END
Go to step 3
NS–67
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
01-DD
Master Reset
DTC
01-E1
Voice Processing Device ON Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
01-DD
Device that should be master has been disconnected
after hybrid system starts.
•
•
01-E1*
Amplifier device records that amplifier output does not
function even while source device is operating.
•
•
Multi-display power source circuit
AVC-LAN circuit between multi-display and
component which has stored this code
Multi-display
Component which has stored this code
HINT:
*: Even if no fault is present, this trouble code may be stored depending on the battery condition or hybrid
system start voltage.
NOTICE:
• Before starting troubleshooting, be sure to clear DTCs to erase codes stored due to the
reasons described in the HINT above. Then, check for DTCs and troubleshoot according to the
output DTCs.
• The multi-display is the master unit.
• Be sure to clear and recheck DTCs after the inspection is completed to confirm that no DTCs
are output.
NS
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
Be sure to read DESCRIPTION before performing the following procedures.
1
CHECK MULTI-DISPLAY POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT
(a) Refer to the multi-display power source circuit (see page
NS-167).
If the power source circuit is operating normally, proceed
to the next step.
NEXT
NS–68
2
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
INSPECT RADIO RECEIVER
(a) Disconnect the R5 and R6 receiver connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance of the receiver.
Standard resistance
Radio Receiver
R5
TX+
Radio Receiver
R6
TX+
TXE126486E01
OK
Specified Condition
R5-9 (TX+) - R5-10 (TX-)
60 to 80 Ω
R6-5 (TX+) - R6-15 (TX-)
60 to 80 Ω
NG
TX-
NS
Tester Connection
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER ASSEMBLY
NS–69
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
3
IDENTIFY COMPONENT WHICH HAS STORED THIS CODE
(a) Enter the diagnostic mode.
(b) Press the "LAN Mon" switch to change to "LAN Monitor"
mode.
(c) Identify the component which has stored this code.
Component table:
Example
Display
Component
AUDIO H/U
Radio receiver
DSP-AMP
Stereo component amplifier
G/W
Gateway ECU
NAVI
Navigation ECU
HINT:
"NAVI" is the component which has stored this code in
the example shown in the illustration.
NS
Component which
has stored this code
DTC
E126492E01
NEXT
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (MULTI-DISPLAY - COMPONENT WHICH HAS STORED THIS
CODE)
HINT:
For details of the connectors, refer to "TERMINALS OF ECU"
(see page NS-40).
(a) Referring to the AVC-LAN wiring diagram below, check
the AVC-LAN circuit between the multi-display and the
component which has stored this code.
(1) Disconnect all connectors between the multi-display
and the component which has stored this code.
(2) Check for an open or short in the AVC-LAN circuit
between the multi-display and the component which
has stored this code.
NS–70
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
OK:
There is no open or short circuit.
AVC-LAN Wiring Diagram
GTX+
TX1+
GTX-
Stereo
Component
Amplifier
(Slave Unit)
TX+
Navigation ECU
(Slave Unit)
TX4-
TX-
Multi-display
(Master Unit)
Gateway ECU
(Slave Unit)
NS
TX4+
TX1-
TX+
TX+
TX-
TX-
TX2-
TX2+
TX-
TX+
Radio Receiver
(Slave Unit)
E126411E03
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
5
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLAY
(a) Replace the multi-display with a normal one and check if
the same problem occurs again.
OK:
Same problem does not occur.
NG
OK
END
REPLACE COMPONENT WHICH HAS
STORED THIS CODE
NS–71
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
01-DF
Master Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
01-DF*
When either condition below is met:
• Device with a display fails and master is switched to
the audio device.
• Communication error between sub-master (radio
receiver) and master occurs.
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
•
Multi-display power source circuit
AVC-LAN circuit between multi-display and
component which has stored this code
AVC-LAN circuit between multi-display and radio
receiver
Multi-display
Component which has stored this code
HINT:
*: When 210 seconds have elapsed after disconnecting the power supply connector of the master
component with the power switch ON (ACC or IG), this code is stored.
NOTICE:
• Before starting troubleshooting, be sure to clear DTCs to erase codes stored due to the
reasons described in the HINT above. Then, check for DTCs and troubleshoot according to the
output DTCs.
• The multi-display is the master unit.
• Be sure to clear and recheck DTCs after the inspection is completed to confirm that no DTCs
are output.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
Be sure to read DESCRIPTION before performing the following procedures.
1
CHECK MULTI-DISPLAY POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT
(a) Refer to the multi-display power source circuit (see page
NS-167).
If the power source circuit is operating normally, proceed
to the next step.
NEXT
NS
NS–72
2
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
INSPECT RADIO RECEIVER
(a) Disconnect the R5 and R6 receiver connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance of the receiver.
Standard resistance
Radio Receiver
R5
TX+
Radio Receiver
R6
TX+
TXE126486E01
OK
Specified Condition
R5-9 (TX+) - R5-10 (TX-)
60 to 80 Ω
R6-5 (TX+) - R6-15 (TX-)
60 to 80 Ω
NG
TX-
NS
Tester Connection
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER ASSEMBLY
NS–73
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
3
IDENTIFY COMPONENT WHICH HAS STORED THIS CODE
(a) Enter the diagnostic mode.
(b) Press the "LAN Mon" switch to change to "LAN Monitor"
mode.
(c) Identify the component which has stored this code.
Component table:
Example
Display
Component
AUDIO H/U
Radio receiver
DSP-AMP
Stereo component amplifier
G/W
Gateway ECU
NAVI
Navigation ECU
HINT:
"NAVI" is the component which has stored this code in
the example shown in the illustration.
NS
Component which
has stored this code
DTC
E126492E01
NEXT
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (MULTI-DISPLAY - COMPONENT WHICH HAS STORED THIS
CODE)
HINT:
For details of the connectors, refer to "TERMINALS OF ECU"
(see page NS-40).
(a) Referring to the AVC-LAN wiring diagram below, check
the AVC-LAN circuit between the multi-display and the
component which has stored this code.
(1) Disconnect all connectors between the multi-display
and the component which has stored this code.
(2) Check for an open or short in the AVC-LAN circuit
between the multi-display and the component which
has stored this code.
NS–74
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
OK:
There is no open or short circuit.
AVC-LAN Wiring Diagram
GTX+
TX1+
GTX-
Stereo
Component
Amplifier
(Slave Unit)
TX+
Navigation ECU
(Slave Unit)
TX4-
TX-
Multi-display
(Master Unit)
Gateway ECU
(Slave Unit)
NS
TX4+
TX1-
TX+
TX+
TX-
TX-
TX2-
TX2+
TX-
TX+
Radio Receiver
(Slave Unit)
E126411E03
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
5
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (MULTI-DISPLAY - RADIO RECEIVER)
HINT:
For details of the connectors, refer to "TERMINALS OF ECU"
(see page NS-40).
(a) Referring to the AVC-LAN wiring diagram below, check
the AVC-LAN circuit between the multi-display and the
radio receiver.
(1) Disconnect all connectors between the multi-display
and the radio receiver.
(2) Check for an open or short in the AVC-LAN circuit
between the multi-display and the radio receiver.
NS–75
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
OK:
There is no open or short circuit.
AVC-LAN Wiring Diagram
TXTX2-
Radio Receiver
Multi-display
TX2+
TX+
E127893E03
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
6
NS
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLAY
(a) Replace the multi-display with a normal one and check if
the same problem occurs again.
OK:
Same problem does not occur.
NG
OK
END
REPLACE COMPONENT WHICH HAS
STORED THIS CODE
NS–76
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
01-E0
Registration Complete Indication Error
DTC
01-E3
Registration Demand Transmission
DTC
01-E4
Multiple Frame Incomplete
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
01-E0
"Registration complete" signal from master device
cannot be received.
-
01-E3
Registration demand signal from the slave device is
output. Or registration demand signal is output by
receiving connection confirmation signal from submaster device.
-
01-E4
Multiple frame transmission is incomplete.
-
HINT:
Even if no fault is present, this trouble code may be stored depending on the battery condition or hybrid
system start voltage.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NS
HINT:
• After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
• These DTCs do not indicate a malfunction.
NS–77
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
01-E2
ON / OFF Indication Parameter Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
01-E2
DTC Detection Condition
Signal for ON / OFF control from master device has
problem.
Trouble Area
Multi-display
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLAY
NEXT
END
NS
NS–78
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
21-10
Panel Switch Error
DTC
21-11
Touch Switch Error
DTC
23-10
Panel Switch Error
DTC
23-11
Touch Switch Error
DTC
24-10
Panel Switch Error
DTC
24-11
Touch Switch Error
DTC
25-10
Panel Switch Error
DTC
25-11
Touch Switch Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
NS
DTC Detection Condition
21-10
Panel switch detection circuit has a problem.
21-11
Touch panel switch has a problem.
23-10
Panel switch detection circuit has a problem.
23-11
Touch panel switch has a problem.
24-10
Panel switch detection circuit has a problem.
24-11
Touch panel switch has a problem.
25-10
Panel switch detection circuit has a problem.
25-11
Touch panel switch has a problem.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
NEXT
END
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLAY
Trouble Area
Multi-display
NS–79
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
34-10
Error in Picture Circuit
DTC
34-11
No Current in Back-light Error
DTC
34-12
Excess Current in Back-light Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
34-10
Error in power supply system for picture circuit
34-11
Decline in power output from inverter circuit for backlight
34-12
Excess power output from inverter circuit for back-light
Trouble Area
Multi-display
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
NEXT
END
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLAY
NS
NS–80
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
57-47
Bluetooth Module Initialization Failed
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
57-47
When one of following conditions is met:
• Bluetooth module is not installed
• Problem with Bluetooth module
• Problem in communication line to Bluetooth module
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
NEXT
END
NS
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLAY
Trouble Area
Multi-display
NS–81
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
58-10
Gyro Error
DTC
80-10
Gyro Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
58-10
Ground short, power supply short, or open circuit in
gyro signal
80-10
Ground short, power supply short, or open circuit in
gyro signal
•
•
Gyro sensor
Navigation ECU
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CHECK VEHICLE SENSOR (NAVIGATION CHECK MODE)
(a) Enter the "Navigation Check" mode (Vehicle Sensors)
(see page NS-24).
(b) Check the gyro voltage.
Standard voltage:
0.5 to 4.5 V
NG
REPLACE NAVIGATION ECU
E120088
OK
2
CLEAR DTC
(a) Clear the DTCs (see page NS-43).
NEXT
3
RECHECK DTC
(a) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble occurs
again.
HINT:
If DTCs are detected frequently, replace the navigation
ECU.
OK:
Malfunction disappears.
NG
REPLACE NAVIGATION ECU
NS
NS–82
OK
END
NS
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–83
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
58-11
GPS Receiver Error
DTC
80-11
GPS Receiver Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
58-11
When either condition below is met:
• RTC, ROM, and RAM of GPS receiver and TCXO
error
• GPS receiver has failed.
80-11
When either condition below is met:
• RTC, ROM, and RAM of GPS receiver and TCXO
error
• GPS receiver has failed.
Trouble Area
Navigation ECU
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
NEXT
END
REPLACE NAVIGATION ECU
NS
NS–84
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
58-40
GPS Antenna Error
DTC
58-41
GPS Antenna Power Source Error
DTC
80-40
GPS Antenna Error
DTC
80-41
GPS Antenna Power Source Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
58-40
GPS antenna error
58-41
Error of power source to GPS antenna
80-40
GPS antenna error
80-41
Error of power source to GPS antenna
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Wire harness
GPS antenna
Navigation ECU
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
NS
1
CHECK HARNESS AND CONNECTOR (GPS ANTENNA - NAVIGATION ECU)
(a) Check that the GPS antenna cord is securely connected
to the navigation ECU.
OK:
The cord is securely connected.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
2
REPLACE GPS ANTENNA
(a) Replace the GPS antenna with a normal one and check
if the same problem occurs again.
(1) Clear the DTCs (see page NS-43).
(2) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble
occurs again.
OK:
Same problem does not occur.
NG
OK
END
REPLACE NAVIGATION ECU
NS–85
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
58-42
Map Disc Read Error
DTC
80-42
Map Disc Read Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
58-42
When one of following conditions is met:
• Player error
• Scratches or dirt on disc
• Access to invalid address due to software error
80-42
When one of following conditions is met:
• Player error
• Scratches or dirt on disc
• Access to invalid address due to software error
Trouble Area
•
•
Map disc
Navigation ECU
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CHECK MAP DISC
(a) Check that the map disc is not deformed or cracked.
OK:
No deformations or cracks on the map disc.
NG
Go to step 4
I100152
OK
2
DISC CLEANING
(a) If dirt is on the disc surface, wipe it clean with a soft cloth
from the inside to the outside in a radial direction.
NOTICE:
Do not use a conventional record cleaner or antistatic preservative.
I100201E04
NEXT
NS
NS–86
3
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC CLEAR AND RECHECK
(a) Clear the DTCs (see page NS-43).
(b) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble occurs
again.
OK:
Same problem does not occur.
OK
END
NG
4
REPLACE MAP DISC
(a) Replace the map disc.
(b) Clear the DTCs and recheck for DTCs.
(c) Check if the same trouble occurs again.
OK:
Same problem does not occur.
OK
NS
NG
REPLACE NAVIGATION ECU
END
NS–87
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
58-43
SPD Signal Error
DTC
80-43
SPD Signal Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
58-43
Difference between GPS speed and SPD pulse is
detected.
80-43
Difference between GPS speed and SPD pulse is
detected.
•
•
Speed signal circuit
Navigation ECU
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CHECK VEHICLE SENSOR (NAVIGATION CHECK MODE)
(a) Enter the "Navigation Check" mode (Vehicle Sensors)
(see page NS-24).
(b) While driving the vehicle, compare the "SPD" indicator to
the reading on the speedometer. Check if these readings
are almost equal.
OK:
The readings are almost equal.
OK
REPLACE NAVIGATION ECU
E120089
NG
2
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS
TABLE
(a) Refer to "Speed signal does not change in the navigation
check mode" in the problem symptoms table.
NEXT
END
NS
NS–88
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
58-44
Player Error
DTC
80-44
Player Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
58-44
Map player error is detected.
80-44
Map player error is detected.
Trouble Area
Navigation ECU
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CHECK NAVIGATION ECU
(a) Check if a disc can be inserted or ejected normally.
OK:
A disc can be inserted or ejected normally.
NG
NS
REPLACE NAVIGATION ECU
OK
2
DTC CLEAR AND RECHECK
(a) Clear the DTCs (see page NS-43).
(b) Recheck for DTCs and check if the same trouble occurs
again.
OK:
Same problem does not occur.
OK
NG
REPLACE NAVIGATION ECU
END
NS–89
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
58-45
High Temperature
DTC
80-45
High Temperature
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
58-45
High map disc player temperature is detected
(Over 80°C (176°F))
80-45
High map disc player temperature is detected
(Over 80°C (176°F))
Trouble Area
Navigation ECU
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
1
CHECK NAVIGATION ECU
(a) Park the vehicle in a cool place.
(b) Check that the temperature of the navigation ECU has
become sufficiently low, then start the engine to verify
the malfunction symptom.
OK:
Same problem does not occur.
NG
OK
END
REPLACE NAVIGATION ECU
NS
NS–90
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
DTC
5C-40
Camera Picture Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Synchronous signal from the camera cannot be
transmitted.
5C-40
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Wire harness
Television camera
Multi-display
WIRING DIAGRAM
Television Camera
Multi-display
CV+
V+
CGND
NS
CGND
CB+
CV-
CA+
Shielded
Shielded
V-
E126423E04
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
After the inspection is completed, clear the DTCs.
NS–91
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
1
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (MULTI-DISPLAY - TELEVISION CAMERA)
(a) Disconnect the M14 display connector.
(b) Disconnect the T13 camera connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Multi-display
M14
V+
V-
CA+ CGND
Television Camera
CV+
CV-
T13
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T13-4 (CB+) - M14-29 (CA+)
Below 1 Ω
T13-3 (CGND) - M14-30 (CGND)
Below 1 Ω
T13-2 (CV+) - M14-27 (V+)
Below 1 Ω
T13-1 (CV-) - M14-28 (V-)
Below 1 Ω
T13-4 (CB+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
T13-3 (CGND) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
T13-2 (CV+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
T13-1 (CV-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
CB+
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
CGND
NS
E126424E04
OK
2
CHECK MULTI-DISPLAY (CA+ VOLTAGE)
(a) Measure the voltage of the display.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
M14
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
M14-29 (CA+) - M14-30
(CGND)
Power switch ON (IG),
shift lever R position
Approx. 6 V
NG
CGND
CA+
E126425E01
OK
REPLACE TELEVISION CAMERA ASSEMBLY
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLAY
NS–92
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
No Sound can be Heard from Speakers
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK AUDIO SETTINGS
(a) Enter the sound adjustment screen by pressing the
"SOUND" switch on the AUDIO display.
(b) Set volume, fader, and balance to the initial values and
check that sound is normal.
OK:
Audio returns to normal.
HINT:
Sound quality adjustment items vary depending on the
type of the amplifier.
E120098
OK
END
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–93
No Image Appears on Multi-display
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DISPLAY SETTING
(a) Check that the display is not in "Screen OFF" mode.
OK:
The display setting is not in "screen OFF" mode.
NG
CHANGE SCREEN TO "SCREEN ON" MODE
OK
2
CHECK IMAGE QUALITY SETTING
(a) Check that the screen color quality can be set.
OK:
Setting is possible.
OK
PRESS PANEL SWITCH "DISPLAY" AND SET
SCREEN COLOR QUALITY TO NORMAL
NG
3
CHECK CABIN
(a) Check that condensation is not likely to occur in the
cabin, and that the temperature is not high or extremely
low in the cabin.
HINT:
• A humid cabin and a rapid change in temperature
may lead to condensation. Condensation in the cabin
may short circuit the screen.
• The appropriate cabin temperature is 20 to 30°C (68
to 86°F).
OK:
Condensation is not likely and temperature is not
high or extremely low.
NG
SET CABIN TO APPROPRIATE
TEMPERATURE
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NS–94
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Illumination for Panel Switch does not Come on with Tail Switch ON
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT NIGHTTIME ILLUMINATION
(a) Turn on the light control switch and check the nighttime
illumination of the vehicle interior.
Result:
Result
Proceed to
Only multi-display nighttime illumination
does not operate
A
No nighttime illumination at all
B
B
GO TO LIGHTING SYSTEM
A
2
CHECK VEHICLE SIGNAL (DISPLAY CHECK MODE)
(a) Enter the "Display Check" mode (Vehicle Signal Check
Mode) (see page NS-18).
(b) Check that the display changes between ON and OFF
according to the light control switch operation.
OK
NS
Light Control Switch
E120054E01
Display
TAIL or ON
ON
OFF
OFF
HINT:
This display is updated once per second. As a result, it is
normal for the display to lag behind the actual change in
the switch.
OK
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLAY
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS–95
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Display does not Dim when Light Control Switch is Turned ON
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK IMAGE QUALITY SETTING
(a) Enter the display adjustment screen by pressing the
"DISPLAY" switch.
(b) Turn the light control switch to the TAIL position.
(c) Check if "Day Mode" on the display is ON.
OK:
"Day Mode" is ON.
OK
TURN "DAY MODE" SETTING OFF
E124058E01
NG
2
CHECK VEHICLE SIGNAL (DISPLAY VEHICLE SIGNAL)
(a) Enter the "Display Check" mode (Vehicle Signal Check
Mode) (see page NS-18).
(b) Check that the display changes between ON and OFF
according to the light control switch operation.
OK
Light Control Switch Condition
I038223E04
Display Condition
TAIL or ON
DIM
OFF
BRIGHT
HINT:
The display is updated once per second. It is normal for
the display to lag behind the actual switch operation.
NG
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLAY
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NS–96
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Panel Switches do not Function
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK PANEL SWITCH
(a) Check for foreign matter around the switch that might
prevent operation.
OK:
No foreign matter is found.
NG
REMOVE ANY FOREIGN MATTER FOUND
OK
2
CHECK PANEL SWITCH (DISPLAY CHECK MODE)
(a) Enter the "Display Check" mode (Panel Switch Check
Mode) (see page NS-18).
(b) Operate the abnormal switch and check if the switch
name and status are correctly displayed.
OK:
The switch name and status are correctly
displayed as operated.
NS
OK
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLAY
E126438
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–97
Touch Panel Switch does not Function
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK TOUCH PANEL
(a) Check for foreign matter on the display.
OK:
The display is clean.
NG
CLEAN DISPLAY AND RECHECK TOUCH
PANEL
OK
2
CHECK TOUCH SWITCH (DISPLAY CHECK MODE)
(a) Enter the "Display Check" mode (Touch Switch Check)
(see page NS-18).
(b) Touch the display in the area where the switch
malfunction occurs.
OK:
A "+" mark appears at the touched position.
NG
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLAY
I100039
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NS–98
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Screen Flicker or Color Distortion
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DISPLAY SETTING
(a) Enter the display adjustment screen by pressing the
"DISP" switch.
(b) Reset display settings (contrast, brightness) and check
that the screen appears normal.
E124059E01
(c) Press the "INFO" switch and then select "Screen
Setting."
NS
I102017
(d) Set the "Switch Color" to "Green" (initial setting) and
check if the display returns to normal.
OK:
Returns to normal.
OK
END
E120097
NG
2
CHECK CABIN
(a) Check that the cabin temperature is warmer than -20°C
(-4.0°F).
OK:
Cabin is warmer than -20°C (-4.0°F).
NG
OK
HEAT CABIN AND RECHECK
TEMPERATURE
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
3
NS–99
CHECK COLOR BAR (DISPLAY CHECK MODE)
(a) Enter the "Display Check" mode (Color Bar Check) (see
page NS-18).
(b) Check that the color bars match the displayed names.
OK:
Color bars match the displayed names.
NG
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLAY
NS
I100037E05
OK
4
CHECK NAVI COLOR BAR (NAVIGATION CHECK MODE)
(a) Enter the "Navigation Check" mode (NAVI Color Bar
Check) (see page NS-24).
(b) Check that the color bars match the displayed names.
OK:
Color bars match the displayed names.
OK
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLAY
I100050E04
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS–100
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
MAP Disc cannot be Inserted
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK MAP DISC
(a) Check that the map disc is not deformed or cracked.
OK:
No deformations or cracks on the map disc.
NG
REPLACE MAP DISC
I100152E12
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–101
MAP Disc cannot be Ejected
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK MULTI-DISPLAY
(a) Turn the power switch ON (ACC).
(b) Keep pressing the MAP eject switch for 5 seconds and
check if the disc is ejected by forced ejection.
OK:
The disc is ejected.
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION
PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM
SYMPTOMS TABLE
OK
2
CHECK MAP DISC
(a) Check that the map disc is not deformed or cracked.
OK:
No deformations or cracks on the map disc.
NG
I100152
OK
END
REPLACE MAP DISC
NS
NS–102
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Vehicle Position Mark Deviates Greatly
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK GPS MARK
(a) Check that the GPS mark is displayed.
OK:
GPS mark is displayed.
NG
GO TO "GPS MARK IS NOT DISPLAYED" IN
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
I100195E01
OK
2
CHECK VEHICLE SENSOR (NAVIGATION CHECK MODE)
NS
(a) Enter the "Navigation Check" mode (Vehicle Sensors)
(see page NS-24).
(b) While driving the vehicle, compare the "Speed" indicator
to the reading on the speedometer. Check that these
readings are almost equal.
OK:
The readings are almost equal.
NG
E120089
GO TO "SPEED SIGNAL DOES NOT
CHANGE IN NAVIGATION CHECK MODE" IN
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
OK
3
CHECK VEHICLE SENSOR (NAVIGATION CHECK MODE)
(a) Check that the display changes between ON and OFF
according to the shift lever operation (P and R).
OK
E120101E01
Shift Lever Position
Display
P
OFF
Reverse position
ON
HINT:
The display is updated once per second. It is normal for
the display to lag behind the actual switch operation.
NG
GO TO "REVERSE SIGNAL DOES NOT
CHANGE IN THE NAVIGATION CHECK
MODE" IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–103
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NS–104
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Cursor or MAP Rotates when Vehicle Stopped
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CONDITION
(a) Check with the customer if the vehicle has been turned
by a turntable at parking.
OK:
Vehicle has not been turned by turntable.
HINT:
If the power switch is turned to the ON (ACC or IG)
position while the vehicle is being turned by a turntable,
the system may store the angular velocity at this time.
For this reason, the vehicle position cursor could deviate.
E106418
NG
TURN POWER SWITCH TO ON (IG)
POSITION WHEN VEHICLE IS COMPLETELY
STOPPED
OK
NS
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–105
Vehicle Position Mark is not Updated
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK MAP DISC
(a) Check that the map disc is not deformed or cracked.
OK:
No deformations or cracks on map disc.
NG
REPLACE MAP DISC
I100152E12
OK
2
CHECK MAP DISPLAY
(a) Check if a touch scroll can be performed on the map
display.
OK:
Touch scroll can be performed.
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION
PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM
SYMPTOMS TABLE
OK
3
CHECK VEHICLE SENSOR (NAVIGATION CHECK MODE)
(a) Enter the "Navigation Check" mode (Vehicle Sensors)
(see page NS-24).
(b) While driving the vehicle, compare the "Speed" indicator
to the reading on the speedometer. Check if these
readings are almost equal.
OK:
The readings are almost equal.
NG
E120089
GO TO "SPEED SIGNAL DOES NOT
CHANGE IN NAVIGATION CHECK MODE" IN
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NS–106
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Current Position Display does not Appear
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK MAP DISC
(a) Check that the map disc is not deformed or cracked.
OK:
No deformations or cracks on the map disc.
NG
REPLACE MAP DISC
I100152E12
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–107
GPS Mark is not Displayed
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CABIN
(a) Check the cabin for any object that might interrupt radio
reception on the instrument panel. If such an object
exists, remove it and check if the GPS mark reappears.
HINT:
The GPS uses extremely faint radio waves originating
from satellites. If the signal is interrupted by obstructions
or other radio waves, the GPS may not be able to
properly receive the signal.
OK:
Mark appears.
OK
NORMAL OPERATION
NG
2
CHECK SURROUNDINGS
NS
(a) Check if the vehicle is in a location where GPS signal
reception is poor. If the vehicle is in such a place,
relocate the vehicle and check if the GPS mark
reappears.
HINT:
The GPS uses 24 satellites in 6 orbits. At any point in
time, 4 satellites should be able to pinpoint your vehicle.
However, GPS signals may not reach the vehicle due to
influence from the surroundings, vehicle direction, and
time. For illustrated examples, see below.
NS–108
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
In a tunnel
NS
In a building
Under an overpass
Between tall buildings
On a forest or tree-lined path
Under a cliff, overhang
I100196E03
OK:
GPS mark is displayed.
OK
SYSTEM RETURN TO NORMAL
NG
3
CHECK GPS INFORMATION (NAVIGATION CHECK MODE)
I102403E01
(a) Enter the "Navigation Check" mode (GPS Information)
(see page NS-24).
(b) Check how many of the following codes appear in the
"STS" column.
For DENSO Made:
T, P
For AISIN AW Made:
08H, 04H
OK:
At least 3 codes appear.
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION
PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM
SYMPTOMS TABLE
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–109
OK
REPLACE NAVIGATION ECU
NS
NS–110
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Voice Guidance does not Function
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK NAVIGATION SYSTEM SETTING
(a) Enter the "Menu" screen by pressing the "MENU" switch.
(b) Select "Volume".
I102018
(c) Check that "OFF" is not selected.
OK:
OFF is not selected.
NG
NS
TURN VOICE GUIDANCE VOLUME UP TO 4
USING VOICE ADJUSTMENT SWITCHES
E124063E01
OK
2
CHECK NAVIGATION SETTING
(a) Enter the "Menu" screen by pressing the "MENU" switch.
(b) Select "Setup".
I102019
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–111
(c) Check that "Voice Guidance in All Modes" is not OFF.
OK:
"Voice Guidance in All Modes" is not OFF.
NG
TURN VOICE GUIDANCE IN ALL MODES
"ON"
I102020
OK
3
CHECK NAVIGATION SETTING
(a) Enter the "Menu" screen by pressing the "MENU" switch.
(b) Select "Setup".
NS
I102019
(c) Check that "Auto Voice Guidance" is not OFF.
OK:
"Auto Voice Guidance" is not OFF.
NG
TURN AUTO VOICE GUIDANCE "ON"
E126439
OK
4
CHECK MAP DISC
(a) Check that the map disc is not deformed or cracked.
OK:
No deformations or cracks on map disc.
NG
I100152
REPLACE MAP DISC
NS–112
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
OK
5
CHECK RADIO RECEIVER
(a) Check that audio can be heard from the speakers.
OK:
Audio can be heard.
NG
GO TO AUDIO AND VISUAL SYSTEM
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–113
MAP Display Incomplete
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK MAP DISC
(a) Check that the map disc is not deformed or cracked.
OK:
No deformations or cracks on map disc.
NG
REPLACE MAP DISC
I100152E12
OK
2
CHECK NAVIGATION DISPLAY
(a) Check that displays other than the navigation display are
complete.
OK:
No other incomplete displays are found.
NG
OK
REPLACE NAVIGATION ECU
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION
PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM
SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NS–114
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Route cannot be Calculated
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK MAP DISC
(a) Check that the map disc is not deformed or cracked.
OK:
No deformations or cracks on map disc.
NG
REPLACE MAP DISC
I100152E12
OK
2
NS
SET DESTINATION
(a) Set another destination and check if the system can
calculate the route correctly.
OK:
Route can be correctly calculated.
NG
OK
END
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION
PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM
SYMPTOMS TABLE
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–115
GYRO Error
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK VEHICLE SENSOR (NAVIGATION CHECK MODE)
(a) Enter the "Navigation Check" mode (Vehicle Sensors)
(see page NS-24).
(b) Check the gyro voltage.
Standard voltage:
0.5 to 4.5 V
NG
REPLACE NAVIGATION ECU
I100048E04
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NS–116
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
MAP Disc Read Error
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK MAP DISC
(a) Check for dirt on the map disc surface.
OK:
No dirt is on the map disc surface.
NOTICE:
Do not use a conventional record cleaner or anti-static
preservative.
HINT:
If the disc is dirty, clean the disc by wiping the disc surface
radially with a soft cloth.
I100201
NG
CLEAN MAP DISC
OK
2
CHECK MAP DISC
NS
(a) Check that the map disc is not deformed or cracked.
OK:
No deformations or cracks appear on the map disc.
NG
REPLACE MAP DISC
I100152
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–117
Voice Recognition Difficulty
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CONDITION
(a) Check if the system's voice recognition level is low by
using only one particular voice.
OK:
System's voice recognition level is low with any
voice.
NG
SYSTEM'S VOICE RECOGNITION LEVEL
VARIES DEPENDING ON VOICE AND
PRONUNCIATION. THIS IS NOT A
MALFUNCTION.
OK
2
CHECK MAP DISC
(a) Check that the map disc is not deformed or cracked.
OK:
No deformations or cracks on map disc.
NG
REPLACE MAP DISC
I100152E12
OK
3
CHECK MAP DISC
(a) Check for dirt on the map disc surface.
OK:
No dirt is on map disc surface.
NOTICE:
Do not use a conventional record cleaner or antistatic preservative.
HINT:
If the disc is dirty, clean the disc by wiping the disc
surface radially with a soft cloth.
I100201E04
OK
NG
CLEAN MAP DISC
NS
NS–118
4
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
CHECK MICROPHONE (NAVIGATION CHECK MODE)
Microphone Input Level Meter
Recording
Switch
Play Switch
Stop Switch
Recording
Indicator
E125118E01
OK
NS
END
(a) Enter the "MICROPHONE & VOICE RECOGNITION
CHECK" mode (see page NS-24).
(b) When a voice is input into the microphone, check that
the microphone input level meter changes according to
the input voice.
(c) Push the recording switch and perform voice recording.
HINT:
The recording limit is 5 seconds.
(d) Check that the recording indicator remains on while
recording and that the recorded voice is played normally
without noise or distortion.
OK:
All check results are normal.
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION
PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM
SYMPTOMS TABLE
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–119
Voice is not Recognized
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK NAVIGATION SETTINGS
(a) Enter the "Menu" screen by pressing the "MENU" switch.
(b) Select "Set up".
I102019
(c) Check that "Voice Recognition Guidance" is not OFF.
OK:
Voice Recognition Guidance is not OFF.
NG
TURN VOICE RECOGNITION GUIDANCE
"ON"
I102025
OK
2
CHECK MAP DISC
(a) Check that the map disc is not deformed or cracked.
OK:
No deformations or cracks on map disc.
NG
I100152E12
OK
REPLACE MAP DISC
NS
NS–120
3
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
CHECK MAP DISC
(a) Check for dirt on the map disc surface.
OK:
No dirt is on the map disc surface.
NOTICE:
Do not use a conventional record cleaner or antistatic preservative.
HINT:
If the disc is dirty, clean the disc by wiping the disc
surface radially with a soft cloth.
I100201E04
NG
CLEAN MAP DISC
OK
4
CHECK MICROPHONE (NAVIGATION CHECK MODE)
NS
Microphone Input Level Meter
Recording
Switch
Play Switch
Stop Switch
Recording
Indicator
E125118E01
NG
(a) Enter the "MICROPHONE & VOICE RECOGNITION
CHECK" mode (see page NS-24).
(b) When a voice is input into the microphone, check that
the microphone input level meter changes according to
the input voice.
(c) Push the recording switch and perform voice recording.
HINT:
The recording limit is 5 seconds.
(d) Check that the recording indicator remains on while
recording and that the recorded voice is played normally
without noise or distortion.
OK:
All check results are normal.
OK
REPLACE NAVIGATION ECU
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
5
NS–121
CHECK MICROPHONE (DISPLAY CHECK MODE)
Microphone Input Level Meter
Recording
Switch
Stop
Switch
Recording
Play
Switch Indicator
(a) Enter the "MICROPHONE & VOICE RECOGNITION
CHECK" mode (see page NS-18).
(b) When a voice is input into the microphone, check that
the microphone input level meter changes according to
the input voice.
(c) Push the recording switch and perform voice recording.
HINT:
The recording limit is 5 seconds.
(d) Check that the recording indicator remains on while
recording and that the recorded voice is played normally
without noise or distortion.
OK:
All check results are normal.
NG
E125811E01
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION
PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM
SYMPTOMS TABLE
OK
END
NS
NS–122
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Cellular Phone Registration Failure, Phone Directory Transfer Failure
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CURRENT CONDITION
(a) Check for Bluetooth capable cellular phones and
vehicles in the area.
Result:
Conditions
Proceed to
Another Bluetooth compatible cellular phone is present
A
Another Bluetooth compatible vehicle is present
B
None of the above
C
B
Go to step 3
C
Go to step 4
A
NS
2
CHECK USING ANOTHER CELLULAR PHONE
(a) Check if the system functions using another Bluetooth
compatible cellular phone.
HINT:
• Confirm that either the same or a different version of
another Bluetooth compatible cellular phone complies
with the system.
• Depending on the version, some Bluetooth
compatible cellular phones cannot be used.
OK:
System functions.
NG
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLAY
OK
USE BLUETOOTH COMPATIBLE CELLULAR PHONE (DEPENDING ON THE VERSION)
3
CHECK USING ANOTHER BLUETOOTH CAPABLE VEHICLE
(a) Register the cellular phone with another vehicle and
check if the system functions normally.
HINT:
Depending on the version, some Bluetooth compatible
cellular phones cannot be used.
OK:
System functions.
OK
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLAY
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–123
NG
USE BLUETOOTH COMPATIBLE CELLULAR PHONE
4
CHECK CELLULAR PHONE
(a) Check if the cellular phone is Bluetooth compatible.
HINT:
Some versions of Bluetooth compatible cellular phones
may not function.
OK:
The phone is Bluetooth compatible.
NG
USE BLUETOOTH COMPATIBLE CELLULAR
PHONE
OK
5
CHECK CELLULAR PHONE
(a) Check if a call can be made from the cellular phone.
HINT:
When the battery is low, registration or directory transfer
cannot be done.
OK:
A call can be made from the cellular phone.
NG
OK
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLAY
REPLACE CELLULAR PHONE
NS
NS–124
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Cellular Phone cannot Send / Receive
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK BLUETOOTH SETTING
(a) Check if the Bluetooth settings are correct.
OK:
Bluetooth settings are correct.
NG
SET SETTINGS CORRECTLY
OK
2
CHECK CELLULAR PHONE
(a) Check if the cellular phone is Bluetooth compatible.
HINT:
Some versions of Bluetooth compatible cellular phones
may not function.
OK:
Phone is Bluetooth compatible.
NS
NG
END (ONLY A BLUETOOTH COMPATIBLE
CELLULAR PHONE CAN BE USED)
OK
3
CHECK SETTING
(a) Check if the cellular phone functions.
HINT:
The cellular phone is unable to call under any of the
following conditions.
• The cellular phone is locked.
• The directory is being transferred.
• The line is crossed.
• Transmission is regulated.
• The power is OFF.
• The cellular phone is not connected to Bluetooth
("Bluetooth mark" is displayed while connected).
OK:
Above conditions do not exist.
NG
SET CORRECTLY
OK
4
CHECK CELLULAR PHONE
(a) Check if the cellular phone can call.
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–125
HINT:
When the battery is low, calls cannot be made or
received.
OK:
Cellular phone can call.
NG
REPLACE CELLULAR PHONE
OK
5
CHECK RECEPTION
(a) Set the cellular phone so that it can receive calls.
(b) Place the cellular phone close to the multi-display.
(c) Check if the cellular phone has reception according to
the multi-display.
OK:
Cellular phone has reception.
NG
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLAY
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NS–126
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Cannot Call in a Certain Place
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK SURROUNDING CONDITION
(a) Check if the cellular phone can make calls in a certain
location.
OK:
It can make calls.
NG
END (CELLULAR PHONES CAN ONLY
FUNCTION IN CELLULAR SERVICE AREAS)
OK
2
CHECK RECEPTION
(a) Enter the "Information" screen by pressing the "INFO"
switch.
(b) Select "Telephone".
NS
I102023
(c) Check the "BT" mark.
Result
I102024
Condition
Proceed to
Yellow color
A
Blue color
B
No connection mark is displayed
C
B
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLAY
C
SELECT A REGISTERED CELLULAR PHONE
OR REGISTER A BLUETOOTH COMPATIBLE
PHONE
A
BRING CELLULAR PHONE TO LOCATION WHERE THE BT MARK TURNS BLUE
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–127
The Other Caller's Voice cannot be Heard, is too Quiet, or Distorted
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CELLULAR PHONE
(a) Check if the voice on the other side can be heard using a
cellular phone.
OK:
Voice can be heard.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE CELLULAR PHONE
OK
2
CHECK NAVIGATION SYSTEM
(a) Check that voice guidance can be heard from the driver
side speaker.
OK:
Voice guidance can be heard.
NG
GO TO "VOICE GUIDANCE DOES NOT
FUNCTION" IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS
TABLE
OK
3
CHECK SETTINGS
(a) Check if the volume level is set to a low level on the
CALL screen.
OK:
The level is not low.
NG
I102027
OK
SET VOLUME TO HIGH
NS
NS–128
4
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
CHECK SETTINGS
E120069E02
(a) Enter the "Handsfree Voice Quality Set" mode (see page
NS-21).
(b) Check if the Receive Voice Level is set to "0".
HINT:
The Receive Voice Level can be set to 11 different
levels, -5 to +5, with a 3 dB difference.
(c) Check if the Receive Voice Level is set to the minimum
or maximum level.
HINT:
When the Receive Voice Level is set to the minimum or
maximum level, the sound may be distorted.
OK:
The Receive Voice Level is set to "0".
NG
SET RECEIVE VOICE LEVEL TO "0"
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–129
The Other Caller cannot Hear Your Voice, or Your Voice is too Quiet or
Distorted
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CELLULAR PHONE
(a) Check if the other side can hear your voice properly.
OK:
Your voice can be heard correctly.
NG
REPLACE CELLULAR PHONE
OK
2
CHECK SETTINGS
(a) Check if the mute switch is set to ON.
OK:
Mute switch is not set to ON.
NG
TURN MUTE SWITCH OFF
I102028
OK
3
CHECK SETTINGS
E120069E04
(a) Enter the "Handsfree Voice Quality Set" mode (see page
NS-21).
(b) Check if the Send Voice Level is set to "0".
HINT:
The Send Voice Level can be set to 11 different levels, -5
to +5, with a 3 dB difference.
(c) Check if the Send Voice Level is set to the minimum or
maximum level.
HINT:
When the Send Voice Level is set to the minimum or
maximum level, the sound may be distorted.
OK:
The Send Voice Level is set to "0".
NG
OK
SET SEND VOICE LEVEL TO "0"
NS
NS–130
4
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
CHECK MICROPHONE (DISPLAY CHECK MODE)
Microphone Input Level Meter
Recording
Switch
Stop
Switch
Recording
Play
Switch Indicator
(a) Enter the "MICROPHONE & VOICE RECOGNITION
CHECK" mode (see page NS-18).
(b) When a voice is input into the microphone, check that
the microphone input level meter changes according to
the input voice.
(c) Push the recording switch and perform voice recording.
HINT:
The recording limit is 5 seconds.
(d) Check that the recording indicator remains on while
recording and that the recorded voice is played normally
without noise or distortion.
OK:
All check results are normal.
NG
E125811E01
OK
NS
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLAY
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION
PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM
SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS–131
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Steering Pad Switch Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This circuit sends an operation signal from the steering pad switch to the radio receiver.
If there is an open in the circuit, the navigation system cannot be operated using the steering pad switch.
If there is a short in the circuit, the resulting condition is the same as if the switch were continuously
depressed. Therefore, the navigation system cannot be operated using the steering pad switch, and the
navigation system itself cannot function.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Steering Pad Switch
Spiral Cable
AU2
VOICE
OFF
HOOK
ON
HOOK
Radio Receiver
SW2
to
AVC-LAN
EAU
SWG
NS
A/C ECU
AC1
ST1
INFO
EAC
SGST
to
BEAN and
AVC-LAN
MAP
AC2
ST2
E126426E02
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
The vehicle is equipped with an SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) which includes
components such as airbags. Before servicing (including removal or installation of parts), be sure
to read the precautionary notice for the Supplemental Restraint System (see page RS-22).
NS–132
1
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
INSPECT STEERING PAD SWITCH ASSEMBLY
MAP Switch
AC1
INFO Switch
AC2
VOICE Switch
OFF HOOK Switch
EAC EAU
ON HOOK Switch
AU2
E126427E01
(a) Disconnect the switch connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the switch.
Standard resistance
NS
Tester connection
9 (AU2) - 8 (EAU)
Specified condition
100 kΩ or higher
9 (AU2) - 8 (EAU)
VOICE switch pushed
3,110 Ω
9 (AU2) - 8 (EAU)
ON HOOK switch
pushed
329 Ω
9 (AU2) - 8 (EAU)
OFF HOOK switch
pushed
1,000 Ω
3 (AC1) - 7 (EAC)
Not pushed
30 kΩ or higher
3 (AC1) - 7 (EAC)
INFO switch pushed
3,062 Ω
2 (AC2) - 7 (EAC)
Not pushed
30 kΩ or higher
2 (AC2) - 7 (EAC)
MAP switch pushed
3,062 Ω
NG
OK
Condition
No switch is pushed
REPLACE STEERING PAD SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
NS–133
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
2
INSPECT SPIRAL CABLE
(a) Disconnect the cable connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance of the cable.
Standard resistance
Steering Pad Switch Side
AU2
AC1
AC2
Tester connection
C12-4 (EAU) - 8 (EAU)
EAU
Spiral Cable Position
Center
Specified condition
Below 1 Ω
2.5 rotations to the left
2.5 rotations to the right
EAC
C12-5 (AU2) - 9 (AU2)
Center
Below 1 Ω
2.5 rotations to the left
2.5 rotations to the right
C12-3 (EAC) - 7 (EAC)
Center
Below 1 Ω
2.5 rotations to the left
2.5 rotations to the right
C12-9 (AC2) - 2 (AC2)
Center
Below 1 Ω
2.5 rotations to the left
Vehicle Side
2.5 rotations to the right
C12-10 (AC1) - 3 (AC1)
Center
Below 1 Ω
2.5 rotations to the left
2.5 rotations to the right
C12 EAC AC2
EAU
AC1
AU2
I102015E07
NOTICE:
The spiral cable is an important part of the SRS
airbag system. Incorrect removal or installation of
the spiral cable may prevent the airbag from
deploying. Be sure to read the page shown in the
brackets (see page RS-22).
NG
OK
REPLACE SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSEMBLY
NS
NS–134
3
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SPIRAL CABLE - RADIO RECEIVER)
(a) Disconnect the R5 receiver connector.
(b) Disconnect the C12 cable connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Radio Receiver
R5
SWG
SW2
Spiral Cable
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
R5-8 (SW2) - C12-5 (AU2)
Below 1 Ω
R5-6 (SWG) - C12-4 (EAU)
Below 1 Ω
R5-8 (SW2) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
R5-6 (SWG) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
C12
EAU
NS
AU2
E127904E01
OK
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SPIRAL CABLE - AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER)
(a) Disconnect the A7 amplifier connector.
(b) Disconnect the C12 cable connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Air Conditioning Amplifier
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A7
A7-2 (ST1) - C12-10 (AC1)
Below 1 Ω
A7-15 (SGST) - C12-3 (EAC)
Below 1 Ω
ST2
A7-1 (ST2) - C12-9 (AC2)
Below 1 Ω
A7-2 (ST1) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
SGST
ST1
Spiral Cable
EAC
C12
AC2
AC1
E126429E02
A7-15 (SGST) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
A7-1 (ST2) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–135
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NS–136
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Illumination Circuit
DESCRIPTION
Power is supplied to the multi-display and steering pad switch illumination when the light control switch is
in the TAIL or HEAD position.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Multi-display
from
PANEL Fuse
NS
ILL+
ILLSteering Pad Switch
Spiral Cable
ILL+
Radio Receiver
EAU
SWG
ILL-
E126430E02
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
The vehicle is equipped with an SRS (Supplemental Restraint System) which includes
components such as airbags. Before servicing (including removal or installation of parts), be sure
to read the precautionary notice for the Supplemental Restraint System (see page RS-22).
NS–137
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
1
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SPIRAL CABLE - BATTERY)
(a) Disconnect the C12 cable connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
Tester connection
C12-12 (ILL+) - Body
ground
C12
NG
ILL+
Condition
Light control switch
TAIL or HEAD
Specified condition
10 to 14 V
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
E126428E01
OK
2
CHECK STEERING PAD SWITCH ASSEMBLY
ILL+
NS
EAU
E126440E01
(a) Disconnect the switch connector.
(b) Connect the positive (+) lead to terminal 5 (ILL+) and the
negative (-) lead to terminal 8 (EAU) of the steering pad
switch connector.
(c) Check if the illumination for the steering pad switch
comes on.
OK:
Illumination for the steering pad switch assembly
comes on.
NG
OK
REPLACE STEERING PAD SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
NS–138
3
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
INSPECT SPIRAL CABLE
(a) Disconnect the cable connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance of the cable.
Standard resistance
Steering Pad Switch Side
ILL+
EAU
Tester Connection
Spiral Cable Position
Specified Condition
C12-4 (EAU) - 8 (EAU)
Center
Below 1 Ω
2.5 rotations to the left
2.5 rotations to the right
C12-12 (ILL+) - 5 (ILL+)
Center
Below 1 Ω
2.5 rotations to the left
2.5 rotations to the right
Vehicle Side
NOTICE:
The spiral cable is an important part of the SRS
airbag system. Incorrect removal or installation of
the spiral cable may prevent the airbag from
deploying. Be sure to read the page shown in the
brackets (see page RS-22).
NG
NS
C12
ILL+
EAU
I102015E08
OK
REPLACE SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSEMBLY
NS–139
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (RADIO RECEIVER - SPIRAL CABLE AND BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the R5 and R6 receiver connectors.
(b) Disconnect the C12 cable connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Radio Receiver
R5
Tester connection
Specified condition
R5-6 (SWG) - C12-4 (EAU)
Below 1 Ω
R6-12 (ILL-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
SWG
NG
Radio Receiver
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
R6
ILLSteering Pad Switch
NS
C12
EAU
E126495E01
OK
5
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (MULTI-DISPLAY - BATTERY AND BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the M14 display connector.
(b) Measure the voltage and resistance of the wire harness
side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
M14
Multi-display
ILL-
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
M14-11 (ILL+) - Body
ground
Light control switch
TAIL or HEAD
10 to 14 V
Standard resistance
ILL+
E126431E03
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
M14-12 (ILL-) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
NS–140
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NS–141
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
AVC-LAN Circuit
DESCRIPTION
Each unit of the navigation system connected to the AVC-LAN (communication bus) transfers the signal of
each switch by communication.
When a short to +B or short to ground occurs in this AVC-LAN, the navigation system will not function
normally as the communication is discontinued.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK RADIO RECEIVER ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the R5 and R6 receiver connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance of the receiver.
Standard resistance
Radio Receiver
R5
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
R6-5 (TX+) - R6-15 (TX-)
60 to 80 Ω
R5-9 (TX+) - R5-10 (TX-)
60 to 80 Ω
NG
TX-
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER ASSEMBLY
NS
TX+
Radio Receiver
R6
TX+
TXE126486E01
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS
HINT:
For details of the connectors, refer to "TERMINALS OF ECU"
(see page NS-40).
(a) Referring to the AVC-LAN wiring diagram below, check
all AVC-LAN circuits.
(1) Disconnect all connectors in all AVC-LAN circuits.
(2) Check for an open or short in all AVC-LAN circuits.
OK:
There is no open or short circuit.
NS–142
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
AVC-LAN Wiring Diagram
GTX+
TX1+
GTX-
NS
TX+
Navigation ECU
(Slave Unit)
TX4-
TX-
Multi-display
(Master Unit)
Gateway ECU
(Slave Unit)
Stereo
Component
Amplifier
(Slave Unit)
TX4+
TX1-
TX+
TX+
TX-
TX-
TX2-
TX2+
TX-
TX+
Radio Receiver
(Slave Unit)
E126411E03
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS–143
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Vehicle Speed Signal Circuit between Navigation ECU and
Combination Meter
DESCRIPTION
This circuit sends a speed signal from combination meter to the navigation ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Navigation ECU
Combination Meter
SPD
I102036E03
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
NS
CHECK OPERATION OF SPEEDOMETER
(a) Drive the vehicle and check if the function of the
speedometer in the combination meter is normal.
OK:
Actual vehicle speed and the speed indicated on
the speedometer are the same.
HINT:
The vehicle speed sensor is functioning normally when
the indication on the speedometer is normal.
NG
OK
GO TO METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
NS–144
2
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (NAVIGATION ECU - COMBINATION METER)
(a) Disconnect the N3 ECU connector.
(b) Disconnect the C10 meter connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Navigation ECU
N3
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
N3-4 (SPD) - C10-13
Below 1 Ω
NG
SPD
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
Combination Meter
C10
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32
NS
E126442E01
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS–145
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Vehicle Speed Signal Circuit between Multi-display and Combination
Meter
DESCRIPTION
The multi-display performs switch operation control during driving by receiving a vehicle speed signal
from the combination meter.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Multi-display
Combination Meter
SPD
I102036E04
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
NS
CHECK OPERATION OF SPEEDOMETER
(a) Drive the vehicle and check if the function of the
speedometer in the combination meter is normal.
OK:
Actual vehicle speed and the speed indicated on
the speedometer are the same.
HINT:
The vehicle speed sensor is functioning normally when
the indication on the speedometer is normal.
NG
OK
GO TO METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
NS–146
2
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (COMBINATION METER - MULTI-DISPLAY)
(a) Disconnect the M13 display connector.
(b) Disconnect the C10 meter connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Multi-display
Tester connection
M13-20 (SPD) - C10-13
M13
NG
SPD
Specified condition
Below 1 Ω
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
Combination Meter
C10
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32
NS
E126441E03
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS–147
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Reverse Signal Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The navigation ECU receives a reverse signal from the BK/UP LP relay and information about the GPS
antenna, and then adjusts vehicle position.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Navigation ECU
to
Rear Combination Lights
BK/UP LP
from
GAUGE Fuse
NS
REV
to
Combination Meter
E126421E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK BACK-UP LIGHT
(a) Move the shift lever to the R position and check if the
back-up lights turn on.
OK:
The back-up lights turn on.
NG
GO TO LIGHTING SYSTEM
NS–148
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
OK
2
CHECK VEHICLE SIGNAL (DISPLAY CHECK MODE)
(a) Enter the "Display Check" mode (Vehicle Signal Check
Mode) (see page NS-18).
(b) Check that the display changes between ON and OFF
according to the shift lever operation (P and R).
OK
E120054E02
Shift Lever Position
Display
Reverse
ON
Except Reverse
OFF
HINT:
This display is updated once per seconds. As a result, it
is normal for the display to lag behind the actual change
in the switch.
OK
REPLACE NAVIGATION ECU
NG
NS
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (BK/UP LP RELAY - NAVIGATION ECU AND BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the N3 ECU connector.
(b) Disconnect the 3H engine room relay block connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Navigation ECU
N3
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
N3-20 (REV) - 3H-8
Below 1 Ω
N3-20 (REV) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REV
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
Engine Room Relay Block
(BK/UP LP Relay)
3H
E126444E01
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS–149
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Navigation Voice Speaker Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This circuit is used when the voice guidance in the navigation system is on.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Stereo Component Amplifier
Multi-display
INT-
IVO-
INT+
IVO+
Navigation ECU
Shielded
SLD
SLD1
VOl-
IVI-
VOl+
IVI+
NS
Shielded
E126488E01
NS–150
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (MULTI-DISPLAY - NAVIGATION ECU)
(a) Disconnect the M14 display connector.
(b) Disconnect the N3 ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Multi-display
M14
Tester Connection
IVI+
IVINavigation ECU
Specified Condition
N3-8 (VOI-) - M14-6 (IVI-)
Below 1 Ω
N3-9 (VOI+) - M14-5 (IVI+)
Below 1 Ω
N3-8 (VOI-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
N3-9 (VOI+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION
PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM
SYMPTOMS TABLE
N3
NS
VOI-
VOI+
E126448E02
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (MULTI-DISPLAY - STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER)
(a) Disconnect the M14 display connector.
(b) Disconnect the S15 amplifier connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Multi-display
M14
IVO+
IVO-
Stereo Component Amplifier
S15
Specified Condition
M14-25 (IVO+) - S15-23 (INT+)
Below 1 Ω
M14-26 (IVO-) - S15-22 (INT-)
Below 1 Ω
M14-25 (IVO+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
M14-26 (IVO-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11 12
13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24
INT-
Tester Connection
INT+
E126443E03
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–151
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NS–152
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Display Signal Circuit between Navigation ECU and Multi-display
DESCRIPTION
This is the display signal circuit from the navigation ECU to the multi-display.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Navigation ECU
Multi-display
GVIF
GVIF
I102036E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (NAVIGATION ECU - MULTI-DISPLAY)
NS
(a) Disconnect the N8 ECU connector.
(b) Disconnect the M16 display connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Navigation ECU
N8
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
N8-1 (GVIF) - M16-1 (GVIF)
Below 1 Ω
N8-1 (GVIF) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
GVIF
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
Multi-display
M16
GVIF
E128289E05
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS–153
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Microphone Circuit between Overhead J/B and Multi-display
DESCRIPTION
This circuit sends a microphone signal from the microphone to the multi-display. It also supplies power
from multi-display to the microphone.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Overhead Junction Block
Multi-display
Microphone
ACC
MACC
MI1+
MIN+
MIC-
MINShielded
NS
Shielded
I102034E02
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK MULTI-DISPLAY (MACC VOLTAGE)
(a) Measure the voltage of the display.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
M14
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
M14-4 (MACC) - Body
ground
Power switch ON (ACC)
10 to 14 V
NG
MACC
OK
E126425E05
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLAY
NS–154
2
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (MULTI-DISPLAY - OVERHEAD JUNCTION BLOCK)
(a) Disconnect the M14 display connector.
(b) Disconnect the O3 junction block connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Multi-display
M14
Tester Connection
MIN+
MIN-
MACC
Overhead Junction Block
Specified Condition
M14-4 (MACC) - O3-7 (ACC)
Below 1 Ω
M14-2 (MIN+) - O3-8 (MI1+)
Below 1 Ω
M14-3 (MIN-) - O3-9 (MIC-)
Below 1 Ω
M14-4 (MACC) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
M14-2 (MIN+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
M14-3 (MIN-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
O3
ACC
NS
MI1+
MIC-
E126436E03
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS–155
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Microphone Circuit between Multi-display and Navigation ECU
DESCRIPTION
This circuit sends a microphone signal from the multi-display to the navigation ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Multi-display
Navigation ECU
SGND
MIC+
MCO+
MIC-
MCO-
Shielded
E126445E02
NS
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (MULTI-DISPLAY - NAVIGATION ECU)
(a) Disconnect the M14 display connector.
(b) Disconnect the N4 ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Multi-display
M14
Tester Connection
M14-22 (MCO+) - N4-3 (MIC+)
MCO+
MCONavigation ECU
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
M14-23 (MCO-) - N4-5 (MIC-)
Below 1 Ω
M14-22 (MCO+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
M14-23 (MCO-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
MIC+
N4
MICE126446E02
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
NS–156
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–157
Gateway ECU Communication Error
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
IDENTIFY COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE
(a) Enter the diagnostic mode.
(b) Press the "LAN Mon" switch to change to "LAN Monitor"
mode.
(c) Identify the component shown by the sub-code.
HINT:
• "110 (multi-display)" is the component shown by the
sub-code in the example shown in the illustration.
• The sub-code will be indicated by its physical
address.
• For the component list, refer to "DIAGNOSIS
DISPLAY DETAILED DESCRIPTION" (see page NS27).
Example
NS
Component which
has stored this code
DTC
Component shown by sub-code
E126492E02
NEXT
2
CHECK POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT OF COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE
(a) Inspect the power source circuit of the component shown
by the sub-code.
If the power source circuit is operating normally, proceed
to the next step.
Component table:
Component
Proceed to
Radio receiver (190)
Radio receiver power source circuit (see page AV-171)
Stereo component amplifier (440)
Stereo component amplifier power source circuit (see page AV-173)
NS–158
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Component
Proceed to
Multi-display (110)
Multi-display power source circuit (see page NS-167)
Navigation ECU (178)
Navigation ECU power source circuit (see page NS-169)
NEXT
3
INSPECT RADIO RECEIVER ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the R5 and R6 receiver connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance of the receiver.
Standard resistance
Radio Receiver
Tester Connection
R5
60 to 80 Ω
R5-9 (TX+) - R5-10 (TX-)
60 to 80 Ω
NG
TX-
Specified Condition
R6-5 (TX+) - R6-15 (TX-)
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER ASSEMBLY
TX+
Radio Receiver
NS
R6
TX+
TXE126486E01
OK
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (GATEWAY ECU - COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE)
HINT:
• Start the check from the circuit that is near the component
shown by the sub-code first.
• For details of the connectors, refer to "TERMINALS OF
ECU" (see page NS-40).
(a) Referring to the AVC-LAN wiring diagram below, check
the AVC-LAN circuit between the gateway ECU and the
component shown by the sub-code.
(1) Disconnect all connectors between the gateway
ECU and the component shown by sub-code.
(2) Check for an open or short in the AVC-LAN circuit
between the gateway ECU and the component
shown by the sub-code.
OK:
There is no open or short circuit.
NS–159
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
AVC-LAN Wiring Diagram
GTX+
TX1+
TX+
Navigation ECU
(Slave Unit)
TX4-
TX-
Multi-display
(Master Unit)
Gateway ECU
(Slave Unit)
GTX-
Stereo
Component
Amplifier
(Slave Unit)
TX4+
TX1-
TX+
TX+
TX-
TX-
TX2-
TX2+
TX-
TX+
NS
Radio Receiver
(Slave Unit)
E126411E03
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
5
REPLACE COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE
(a) Replace the component shown by the sub-code with a
normal one and check if the same problem occurs again.
OK:
Same problem does not occur.
NG
OK
END
REPLACE GATEWAY ECU
NS–160
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Radio Receiver Communication Error
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
IDENTIFY COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE
(a) Enter the diagnostic mode.
(b) Press the "LAN Mon" switch to change to "LAN Monitor"
mode.
(c) Identify the component shown by the sub-code.
HINT:
• "110 (multi-display)" is the component shown by the
sub-code in the example shown in the illustration.
• The sub-code will be indicated by its physical
address.
• For the component list, refer to "DIAGNOSIS
DISPLAY DETAILED DESCRIPTION" (see page NS27).
Example
NS
DTC
Component shown by sub-code
E126492E04
NEXT
2
CHECK POWER
(a) Inspect the power source circuit of the component shown
by the sub-code.
If the power source circuit is operating normally, proceed
to the next step.
Component table:
Component
Proceed to
Gateway ECU (1C6)
Gateway ECU power source circuit (see page AV-171)
Stereo component amplifier (440)
Stereo component amplifier power source circuit (see page AV-173)
NS–161
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Component
Proceed to
Multi-display (110)
Multi-display power source circuit (see page NS-167)
Navigation ECU (178)
Navigation ECU power source circuit (see page NS-169)
NEXT
3
INSPECT RADIO RECEIVER ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the R5 and R6 receiver connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance of the receiver.
Standard resistance
Radio Receiver
Tester Connection
R5
60 to 80 Ω
R5-9 (TX+) - R5-10 (TX-)
60 to 80 Ω
NG
TX-
Specified Condition
R6-5 (TX+) - R6-15 (TX-)
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER ASSEMBLY
TX+
Radio Receiver
NS
R6
TX+
TXE126486E01
OK
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (RADIO RECEIVER - COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE)
HINT:
• Start the check from the circuit that is near the component
shown by the sub-code first.
• For details of the connectors, refer to "TERMINALS OF
ECU" (see page NS-40).
(a) Referring to the AVC-LAN wiring diagram below, check
the AVC-LAN circuit between the radio receiver and the
component shown by the sub-code.
(1) Disconnect all connectors between the radio
receiver and the component shown by sub-code.
(2) Check for an open or short in the AVC-LAN circuit
between the radio receiver and the component
shown by the sub-code.
OK:
There is no open or short circuit.
NS–162
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
AVC-LAN Wiring Diagram
GTX+
TX1+
GTX-
NS
TX+
Navigation ECU
(Slave Unit)
TX4-
TX-
Multi-display
(Master Unit)
Gateway ECU
(Slave Unit)
Stereo
Component
Amplifier
(Slave Unit)
TX4+
TX1-
TX+
TX+
TX-
TX-
TX2-
TX2+
TX-
TX+
Radio Receiver
(Slave Unit)
E126411E03
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
5
REPLACE COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE
(a) Replace the component shown by the sub-code with a
normal one and check if the same problem occurs again.
OK:
Same problem does not occur.
NG
OK
END
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER ASSEMBLY
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–163
Stereo Component Amplifier Communication Error
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
IDENTIFY COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE
(a) Enter the diagnostic mode.
(b) Press the "LAN Mon" switch to change to "LAN Monitor"
mode.
(c) Identify the component shown by the sub-code.
HINT:
• "110 (multi-display)" is the component shown by the
sub-code in the example shown in the illustration.
• The sub-code will be indicated by its physical
address.
• For the component list, refer to "DIAGNOSIS
DISPLAY DETAILED DESCRIPTION" (see page NS27).
Example
NS
DTC
Component shown by sub-code
E126492E04
NEXT
2
CHECK POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT OF COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE
(a) Inspect the power source circuit of the component shown
by the sub-code.
If the power source circuit is operating normally, proceed
to the next step.
Component table:
Component
Proceed to
Radio receiver (190)
Radio receiver power source circuit (see page AV-171)
Gateway ECU (1C6)
Gateway ECU power source circuit (see page AV-173)
NS–164
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Component
Proceed to
Multi-display (110)
Multi-display power source circuit (see page NS-167)
Navigation ECU (178)
Navigation ECU power source circuit (see page NS-169)
NEXT
3
INSPECT RADIO RECEIVER ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the R5 and R6 receiver connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance of the receiver.
Standard resistance
Radio Receiver
Tester Connection
TX+
Specified Condition
R6-5 (TX+) - R6-15 (TX-)
60 to 80 Ω
R5-9 (TX+) - R5-10 (TX-)
60 to 80 Ω
R5
NG
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER ASSEMBLY
TXRadio Receiver
NS
R6
TX-
TX+
E126489E01
OK
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (STEREO COMPONENT AMPLIFIER - COMPONENT SHOWN BY
SUB-CODE)
HINT:
• Start the check from the circuit that is near the component
shown by the sub-code first.
• For details of the connectors, refer to "TERMINALS OF
ECU" (see page NS-40).
(a) Referring to the AVC-LAN wiring diagram below, check
the AVC-LAN circuit between the stereo component
amplifier and the component shown by the sub-code.
(1) Disconnect all connectors between the stereo
component amplifier and the component shown by
sub-code.
(2) Check for an open or short in the AVC-LAN circuit
between the stereo component amplifier and the
component shown by the sub-code.
OK:
There is no open or short circuit.
NS–165
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
AVC-LAN Wiring Diagram
GTX+
TX1+
TX+
Navigation ECU
(Slave Unit)
TX4-
TX-
Multi-display
(Master Unit)
Gateway ECU
(Slave Unit)
GTX-
Stereo
Component
Amplifier
(Slave Unit)
TX4+
TX1-
TX+
TX+
TX-
TX-
TX2-
TX2+
TX-
TX+
NS
Radio Receiver
(Slave Unit)
E126411E03
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
5
REPLACE COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE
(a) Replace the component shown by the sub-code with a
normal one and check if the same problem occurs again.
OK:
Same problem does not occur.
NG
OK
END
REPLACE STEREO COMPONENT
AMPLIFIER
NS–166
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Multi-display Communication Error
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
IDENTIFY COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE
(a) Enter the diagnostic mode.
(b) Press the "LAN Mon" switch to change to "LAN Monitor"
mode.
(c) Identify the component shown by the sub-code.
HINT:
• "110 (multi-display)" is the component shown by the
sub-code in the example shown in the illustration.
• The sub-code will be indicated by its physical
address.
• For the component list, refer to "DIAGNOSIS
DISPLAY DETAILED DESCRIPTION" (see page NS27).
Example
NS
DTC
Component shown by sub-code
E126492E04
NEXT
2
CHECK POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT OF COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE
(a) Inspect the power source circuit of the component shown
by the sub-code.
If the power source circuit is operating normally, proceed
to the next step.
Component table:
Component
Proceed to
Radio receiver (190)
Radio receiver power source circuit (see page AV-171)
Stereo component amplifier (440)
Stereo component amplifier power source circuit (see page AV-173)
NS–167
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Component
Proceed to
Gateway ECU (1C6)
Gateway ECU power source circuit (see page AV-177)
Navigation ECU (178)
Navigation ECU power source circuit (see page NS-169)
NEXT
3
CHECK RADIO RECEIVER ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the R5 and R6 receiver connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance of the receiver.
Standard resistance
Radio Receiver
Tester Connection
R5
60 to 80 Ω
R5-9 (TX+) - R5-10 (TX-)
60 to 80 Ω
NG
TX-
Specified Condition
R6-5 (TX+) - R6-15 (TX-)
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER ASSEMBLY
TX+
Radio Receiver
NS
R6
TX+
TXE126486E01
OK
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (MULTI-DISPLAY - COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE)
HINT:
• Start the check from the circuit that is near the component
shown by the sub-code first.
• For details of the connectors, refer to "TERMINALS OF
ECU" (see page NS-40).
(a) Referring to the AVC-LAN wiring diagram below, check
the AVC-LAN circuit between the multi-display and the
component shown by the sub-code.
(1) Disconnect all connectors between the multi-display
and the component shown by sub-code.
(2) Check for an open or short in the AVC-LAN circuit
between the multi-display and the component
shown by the sub-code.
OK:
There is no open or short circuit.
NS–168
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
AVC-LAN Wiring Diagram
GTX+
TX1+
GTX-
NS
TX+
Navigation ECU
(Slave Unit)
TX4-
TX-
Multi-display
(Master Unit)
Gateway ECU
(Slave Unit)
Stereo
Component
Amplifier
(Slave Unit)
TX4+
TX1-
TX+
TX+
TX-
TX-
TX2-
TX2+
TX-
TX+
Radio Receiver
(Slave Unit)
E126411E03
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
5
REPLACE COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE
(a) Replace the component shown by the sub-code with a
normal one and check if the same problem occurs again.
OK:
Same problem does not occur.
NG
OK
END
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLAY
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
NS–169
Navigation ECU Communication Error
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
IDENTIFY COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE
(a) Enter the diagnostic mode.
(b) Press the "LAN Mon" switch to change to "LAN Monitor"
mode.
(c) Identify the component shown by the sub-code.
HINT:
• "110 (multi-display)" is the component shown by the
sub-code in the example shown in the illustration.
• The sub-code will be indicated by its physical
address.
• For the component list, refer to "DIAGNOSIS
DISPLAY DETAILED DESCRIPTION" (see page NS27).
Example
NS
DTC
Component shown by sub-code
E126492E04
NEXT
2
CHECK POWER SOURCE CIRCUIT OF COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE
(a) Inspect the power source circuit of the component shown
by the sub-code.
If the power source circuit is operating normally, proceed
to the next step.
Component table:
Component
Proceed to
Radio receiver (190)
Radio receiver power source circuit (see page AV-171)
Stereo component amplifier (440)
Stereo component amplifier power source circuit (see pageAV-173 )
NS–170
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Component
Proceed to
Multi-display (110)
Multi-display power source circuit (see page NS-167)
Gateway ECU (1C6)
Gateway ECU power source circuit (see page AV-177)
NEXT
3
INSPECT RADIO RECEIVER ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the R5 and R6 receiver connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance of the receiver.
Standard resistance
Radio Receiver
R5
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
R6-5 (TX+) - R6-15 (TX-)
60 to 80 Ω
R5-9 (TX+) - R5-10 (TX-)
60 to 80 Ω
NG
TX-
REPLACE RADIO RECEIVER ASSEMBLY
TX+
Radio Receiver
NS
R6
TX+
TXE126486E01
OK
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (NAVIGATION ECU - COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE)
HINT:
• Start the check from the circuit that is near the component
shown by the sub-code first.
• For details of the connectors, refer to "TERMINALS OF
ECU" (see page NS-40).
(a) Referring to the AVC-LAN wiring diagram below, check
the AVC-LAN circuit between the navigation ECU and
the component shown by the sub-code.
(1) Disconnect all connectors between the navigation
ECU and the component shown by sub-code.
(2) Check for an open or short in the AVC-LAN circuit
between the navigation ECU and the component
shown by the sub-code.
OK:
There is no open or short circuit.
NS–171
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
AVC-LAN Wiring Diagram
GTX+
TX1+
TX+
Navigation ECU
(Slave Unit)
TX4-
TX-
Multi-display
(Master Unit)
Gateway ECU
(Slave Unit)
GTX-
Stereo
Component
Amplifier
(Slave Unit)
TX4+
TX1-
TX+
TX+
TX-
TX-
TX2-
TX2+
TX-
TX+
NS
Radio Receiver
(Slave Unit)
E126411E03
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
5
REPLACE COMPONENT SHOWN BY SUB-CODE
(a) Replace the component shown by the sub-code with a
normal one and check if the same problem occurs again.
OK:
Same problem does not occur.
NG
OK
END
REPLACE NAVIGATION ECU
NS–172
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Multi-display Power Source Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The circuit provides power to the multi-display.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Multi-display
ECU-B
from
Battery
from
ACC Relay
ACC
from
IG1 Relay
ECU-IG
+B1
ACC
IG
GND1
NS
E126437E02
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT FUSE (ACC, ECU-B, ECU-IG)
(a) Disconnect the ACC, ECU-B and ECU-IG fuses from the
driver side junction block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the fuses.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
OK
REPLACE FUSE
NS–173
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (MULTI-DISPLAY - BATTERY AND BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the M13 display connector.
(b) Measure the resistance and voltage of the wire harness
side connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
M13
GND1
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
M13-1 (GND1) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
Standard voltage
ACC
+B1
IG
B122460E08
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
M13-3 (+B1) - Body
ground
Always
10 to 14 V
M13-2 (ACC) - Body
ground
Power switch ON (ACC)
10 to 14 V
M13-10 (IG) - Body
ground
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NS–174
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
Navigation ECU Power Source Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This is the power source circuit to operate the navigation ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Navigation ECU
DOME
from
Battery
ACC
from
ACC Relay
+B
ACC
GND1
NS
I101984E09
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT FUSE (DOME, ACC)
(a) Disconnect the DOME fuse from the engine room
junction block.
(b) Disconnect the ACC fuse from the driver side junction
block.
(c) Measure the resistance of the fuses.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
OK
REPLACE FUSE
NS–175
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION SYSTEM
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (NAVIGATION ECU - BATTERY AND BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the N3 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the voltage and resistance of the wire harness
side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
N3
+B
ACC
GND1
E126483E01
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
N3-1 (+B) - Body ground
Always
10 to 14 V
N3-13 (ACC) - Body
ground
Power switch ON (ACC)
10 to 14 V
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
N3-15 (GND1) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NS
NS–171
NAVIGATION – MULTI-DISPLAY
MULTI-DISPLAY
BODY ELECTRICAL
NAVIGATION
COMPONENTS
MULTI-DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
NS
NO. 3 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER ASSEMBLY
NO. 4 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER ASSEMBLY
B139835E01
NS–172
NAVIGATION – MULTI-DISPLAY
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE NO. 3 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-6)
3.
REMOVE NO. 4 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-6)
4.
REMOVE MULTI-DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 bolts.
(b) Disconnect the connector and remove the multidisplay.
I039616E01
NS
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL MULTI-DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
(a) Connect the connector and install the multi-display.
(b) Install the 2 bolts.
2.
INSTALL NO. 4 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-12)
3.
INSTALL NO. 2 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-13)
4.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
5.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
I039616E01
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION ECU
NS–173
NAVIGATION ECU
BODY ELECTRICAL
NAVIGATION
COMPONENTS
NS
NAVIGATION ECU COVER
NO. 2 DISC PLAYER
BRACKET
NO. 1 DISC PLAYER BRACKET
NAVIGATION ECU
B139843E01
NS–174
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION ECU
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY LH (See page SE4)
3.
REMOVE NAVIGATION ECU COVER
(a) Detach the 2 clips and remove the navigation ECU
cover.
4.
REMOVE NAVIGATION ECU WITH BRACKET
(a) Disconnect the connector.
I039611E01
(b) Remove the 3 bolts and navigation ECU with
bracket.
NS
I039612E01
5.
REMOVE NO. 1 DISC PLAYER BRACKET
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and disc player bracket.
6.
REMOVE NO. 2 DISC PLAYER BRACKET
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and No. 2 disc player bracket.
I039613E01
I039614E01
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION ECU
NS–175
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL NO. 2 DISC PLAYER BRACKET
(a) Install the bracket with the 2 bolts.
2.
INSTALL NO. 1 DISC PLAYER BRACKET
(a) Install the bracket with the 2 bolts.
3.
INSTALL NAVIGATION ECU WITH BRACKET
(a) Install the navigation ECU with the 3 bolts.
(b) Connect the connector.
I039614E01
I039613E01
I039612E01
I039611E01
4.
INSTALL NAVIGATION ECU COVER
(a) Install the cover and attach the 2 clips.
5.
INSTALL FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY LH (See page SE10)
6.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
7.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
NS
NS–176
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION ANTENNA
NAVIGATION ANTENNA
BODY ELECTRICAL
NAVIGATION
COMPONENTS
NAVIGATION ANTENNA ASSEMBLY
NS
B136396E01
NAVIGATION – NAVIGATION ANTENNA
NS–177
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the instrument panel (see page IP-5).
3.
REMOVE NAVIGATION ANTENNA ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 screws and detach the 3 clamps to
remove the navigation antenna.
I038870E02
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL NAVIGATION ANTENNA ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the navigation antenna with the 2 screws and
attach the 3 clamps.
2.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the instrument panel (see page IP-11).
3.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
4.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
I038870E02
NS
OT–1
OTHER SYSTEM – CLOCK
CLOCK
BODY ELECTRICAL
OTHER
SYSTEM
COMPONENTS
CLOCK ASSEMBLY
MULTI-DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
UPPER INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL
SUB-ASSEMBLY
OT
NO. 3 INSTRUMENT PANEL
REGISTER ASSEMBLY
NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER ASSEMBLY
NO. 4 INSTRUMENT PANEL
REGISTER ASSEMBLY
LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
B131355E02
OT–2
OTHER SYSTEM – CLOCK
REMOVAL
OT
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-5)
3.
REMOVE NO. 3 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-6)
4.
REMOVE LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page IP-6)
5.
REMOVE UPPER INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page IP-6)
6.
REMOVE NO. 4 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-6)
7.
REMOVE MULTI-DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
8.
REMOVE CLOCK ASSEMBLY
(a) Detach the 2 claws and remove the clock.
B074089E04
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL CLOCK ASSEMBLY
(a) Attach the 2 claws to install the clock.
2.
INSTALL MULTI-DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
3.
INSTALL NO. 4 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-12)
4.
INSTALL UPPER INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page IP-13)
5.
INSTALL LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page IP-13)
6.
INSTALL NO. 3 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-13)
7.
INSTALL NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-13)
8.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
B074089E05
OTHER SYSTEM – CLOCK
9.
OT–3
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
10. CHECK SRS WARNING LIGHT
(a) Check the SRS warning light (see page RS-31).
OT
OT–4
OTHER SYSTEM – TELLTALE LIGHT
TELLTALE LIGHT
BODY ELECTRICAL
OTHER
SYSTEM
COMPONENTS
NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL SPEAKER PANEL
SUB-ASSEMBLY (w/ JBL Sound System)
FRONT PILLAR GARNISH RH
FRONT PILLAR GARNISH CORNER PIECE RH
FRONT PILLAR GARNISH LH
FRONT PILLAR GARNISH CORNER PIECE LH
D
D
OT
D
INSTRUMENT PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
A
20 (204, 15)
A
INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH PANEL END
CLOCK ASSEMBLY
MULTI-DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B126622E03
OT–5
OTHER SYSTEM – TELLTALE LIGHT
INSTRUMENT PANEL HOLE COVER
GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR
INSTRUMENT PANEL HOLE COVER
UPPER INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL
SUB-ASSEMBLY
NO. 2 INSTRUMENT PANEL
REGISTER ASSEMBLY
NO. 4 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY
NO. 3 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY
OT
INSTRUMENT PANEL CUSHION
NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER ASSEMBLY
GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR STOPPER SUB-ASSEMBLY
E
E
LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR ASSEMBLY
B126623E04
OT–6
OTHER SYSTEM – TELLTALE LIGHT
TELLTALE LIGHT ASSEMBLY
INSTRUMENT PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
B132483E01
OT
OTHER SYSTEM – TELLTALE LIGHT
OT–7
REMOVAL
2 Claws
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the instrument panel (see page IP-5).
3.
REMOVE TELLTALE LIGHT ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Detach the 2 claws and remove the telltale light.
B074056E04
INSTALLATION
2 Claws
1.
INSTALL TELLTALE LIGHT ASSEMBLY
(a) Attach the 2 claws to install the telltale light.
(b) Connect the connector.
2.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the instrument panel (see page IP-11).
3.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
4.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
5.
CHECK SRS WARNING LIGHT
(a) Check the SRS warning light (see page RS-31).
B074056E05
OT
OT–8
OTHER SYSTEM – POWER OUTLET SOCKET
POWER OUTLET SOCKET
BODY ELECTRICAL
OTHER
SYSTEM
COMPONENTS
OT
POWER OUTLET SOCKET COVER
POWER OUTLET SOCKET ASSEMBLY
B136398E01
OTHER SYSTEM – POWER OUTLET SOCKET
OT–9
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE POWER OUTLET SOCKET ASSEMBLY
(a) Detach the claw to remove the power outlet socket.
I038883E02
OT
OT–10
OTHER SYSTEM – POWER OUTLET SOCKET
INSTALLATION
OT
1.
INSTALL POWER OUTLET SOCKET ASSEMBLY
(a) Align the power outlet socket and power outlet
socket cover. Insert them from the front side into the
vehicle body and install the power outlet socket.
2.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
3.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
OT–10
OTHER SYSTEM – REAR POWER OUTLET SOCKET
REAR POWER OUTLET SOCKET
BODY ELECTRICAL
OTHER
SYSTEM
COMPONENTS
OT
POWER OUTLET SOCKET COVER
REAR POWER OUTLET SOCKET ASSEMBLY
B136399E01
OTHER SYSTEM – REAR POWER OUTLET SOCKET
OT–11
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE REAR POWER OUTLET SOCKET
ASSEMBLY
(a) Detach the claw to remove the rear power outlet
socket.
I038884E02
OT
OT–12
OTHER SYSTEM – REAR POWER OUTLET SOCKET
INSTALLATION
OT
1.
INSTALL REAR POWER OUTLET SOCKET
ASSEMBLY
(a) Align the rear power outlet socket assembly and
power outlet socket cover. Insert them from the front
side into the vehicle body and install the rear power
outlet socket assembly.
2.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
3.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
PB–1
PARKING BRAKE – PARKING BRAKE SYSTEM
PARKING BRAKE SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
Use the table below to help determine the cause of the
problem symptom. The potential causes of the symptoms are
listed in order of probability in the "Suspected area" column of
the table. Check each symptom by checking the suspected
areas in the order they are listed. Replace parts as
necessary.
Parking brake system
Symptom
Brake drags
Suspected area
See page
1. Parking brake pedal travel (Adjustment necessary)
PB-1
2. Parking brake wire (Sticking)
PB-14
3. Parking brake shoe clearance (Adjustment necessary)
BR-53
4. Parking brake shoe (Cracked or distorted)
BR-47
5. Tension spring (Damaged)
BR-47
PB
PB–2
PARKING BRAKE – PARKING BRAKE SYSTEM
ADJUSTMENT
1.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
2.
ADJUST PARKING BRAKE SHOE CLEARANCE (See
page BR-53)
3.
INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 103 N*m (1,050 kgf*cm, 76 ft.*lbf)
4.
CHECK PARKING BRAKE PEDAL TRAVEL
(a) Firmly depress the parking brake pedal.
(b) Release the parking brake.
(c) Slowly depress the parking brake pedal all the way
again and count the number of clicks.
Standard parking brake pedal travel:
6 to 9 clicks at 300 N (31 kgf)
5.
ADJUST PARKING BRAKE PEDAL TRAVEL
(a) Remove the rear console box (see page IP-24).
HINT:
Refer to the procedures from the removal of the
upper console panel sub-assembly up until the
removal of the rear console box sub-assembly.
(b) Remove the front floor footrest (see page SR-10).
(c) Remove the 8 bolts and front floor crossmember
reinforcement LH.
(d) Slide the cover to the rear of the vehicle as shown in
the illustration.
Cover
F047477E01
Lock Nut
Adjusting Nut
F047478E01
PB
(e) Depress the parking brake pedal 5 clicks. Hold the
adjusting nut using a wrench and loosen the lock
nut.
(f) Release the parking brake.
(g) Turn the lock nut and adjusting nut until parking
brake travel is within the specified range.
Torque: 12.5 N*m (127 kgf*cm, 9 ft.*lbf)
(h) Count the number of clicks after depressing and
releasing the parking brake pedal 3 to 4 times.
(i) Check whether the parking brake drags or not.
(j) When operating the parking brake pedal, check that
the parking brake pedal indicator light comes on.
PARKING BRAKE – PARKING BRAKE SYSTEM
Cover
F047477E02
PB–3
(k) Return the cover to the original position as shown in
the illustration.
(l) Install the front floor crossmember reinforcement LH
with the 8 bolts.
Torque: 18 N*m (184 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
(m) Install the front floor footrest (see page SR-13).
(n) Install the rear console box (see page IP-25).
HINT:
Refer to the procedures from the installation of the
rear console box sub-assembly up until the
installation of the upper console panel subassembly.
PB
PB–3
PARKING BRAKE – PARKING BRAKE PEDAL
PARKING BRAKE PEDAL
PARKING BRAKE
BRAKE
COMPONENTS
PARKING BRAKE CONTROL PEDAL ASSEMBLY
20 (204, 15)
20 (204, 15)
20 (204, 15)
NO. 1 WIRE
ADJUSTING NUT
PARKING BRAKE
SWITCH ASSEMBLY
5.4 (55, 48 in.*lbf)
LOCK NUT
CLIP
PARKING PEDAL PAD
NO. 1 PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSEMBLY
PB
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
C130372E01
PB–4
PARKING BRAKE – PARKING BRAKE PEDAL
FRONT FLOOR FOOTREST
NO. 1 CONSOLE BOX
MOUNTING BRACKET
14 (143, 10)
NO. 1 FRONT FLOOR SIDE
REINFORCEMENT
14 (143, 10)
14 (143, 10)
PARKING BRAKE FRONT
CABLE CLAMP
NO. 1 PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSEMBLY
PARKING BRAKE INTERMEDIATE LEVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
PB
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
C130373E01
PARKING BRAKE – PARKING BRAKE PEDAL
PB–5
REMOVAL
1.
DISCHARGE REFRIGERANT FROM
REFRIGERATION SYSTEM (See page AC-140)
2.
DISCONNECT SUCTION HOSE SUB-ASSEMBLY (See
page AC-146)
3.
DISCONNECT COOLER REFRIGERANT LIQUID PIPE
E (TO COOLER UNIT) (See page AC-146)
4.
DISCONNECT HEATER WATER HOSE B (See page
AC-146)
5.
DISCONNECT HEATER WATER HOSE A (See page
AC-146)
6.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page HB153)
7.
REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page HB153)
8.
REMOVE REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page HB153)
9.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
10. REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the instrument panel (see page IP-5).
HINT:
Refer to the procedures from the removal of the No.
1 instrument panel register assembly up until the
removal of the instrument panel sub-assembly.
11. REMOVE NO. 2 STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER
12. REMOVE NO. 3 STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER
13. REMOVE STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY (See page RS268)
14. REMOVE STEERING WHEEL ASSEMBLY (See page
SR-8)
15. REMOVE TILT LEVER BRACKET (See page SR-8)
16. REMOVE STEERING COLUMN COVER (See page
SR-8)
17. REMOVE TURN SIGNAL SWITCH ASSEMBLY WITH
SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page SR-8)
18. REMOVE FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH (See page
IR-7)
19. REMOVE FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH (See page
IR-7)
PB
PB–6
PARKING BRAKE – PARKING BRAKE PEDAL
20. REMOVE COWL SIDE TRIM BOARD LH (See page IR7)
21. REMOVE COWL SIDE TRIM BOARD RH (See page
IR-7)
22. REMOVE CENTER INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH
PANEL ASSEMBLY (See page IP-18)
23. REMOVE RADIO RECEIVER ASSEMBLY
24. REMOVE LOWER CENTER INSTRUMENT PANEL
FINISH PANEL (See page IP-18)
25. REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR LOCK
COVER (See page IP-18)
26. REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR LOCK
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-18)
27. REMOVE LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH
PANEL (See page IP-19)
28. REMOVE NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL UNDER
COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page IP-19)
29. REMOVE POWER STEERING ECU (See page SR-17)
30. REMOVE SHIFT LEVER ASSEMBLY (See page HX124)
31. REMOVE REAR NO. 3 AIR DUCT (See page AC-147)
32. REMOVE NO. 3 HEATER TO REGISTER DUCT (See
page AC-147)
33. REMOVE NO. 1 HEATER TO REGISTER DUCT (See
page AC-147)
34. REMOVE NO. 2 HEATER TO REGISTER DUCT (See
page AC-147)
35. REMOVE DEFROSTER NOZZLE ASSEMBLY (See
page AC-148)
36. REMOVE ECM (See page ES-469)
37. REMOVE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU (See
page HV-543)
38. REMOVE NETWORK GATEWAY ECU
39. REMOVE NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACE SUBASSEMBLY (See page AC-148)
PB
40. REMOVE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
ASSEMBLY (See page AC-179)
41. REMOVE STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY (See page
SR-11)
42. REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL REINFORCEMENT
ASSEMBLY (See page AC-148)
43. REMOVE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY LH/RH
(a) Remove the front seat LH/RH (see page SE-4).
PARKING BRAKE – PARKING BRAKE PEDAL
PB–7
44. REMOVE UPPER CONSOLE PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
(See page IP-24)
45. REMOVE CONSOLE BOX POCKET
46. REMOVE CONSOLE BOX CARPET
47. REMOVE REAR CONSOLE BOX SUB-ASSEMBLY
(See page IP-24)
48. REMOVE FRONT FLOOR FOOTREST (See page SR10)
49. REMOVE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
(See page RS-306)
50. REMOVE YAW RATE SENSOR (w/ VSC) (See page
BC-224)
51. REMOVE NO. 1 CONSOLE BOX MOUNTING
BRACKET
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and No. 1 console box
mounting bracket.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and No. 1 front floor side
reinforcement.
G028423E02
52. REMOVE PARKING BRAKE CONTROL PEDAL
ASSEMBLY
(a) Release the parking brake.
(b) Remove the 2 No. 1 parking brake cable clamp nuts
and parking brake front cable clamp.
PB
G028431E01
PB–8
PARKING BRAKE – PARKING BRAKE PEDAL
(c) Remove the clamp bolt from the No. 1 parking brake
cable.
G028419E01
Bolt A
(d) Disconnect the No. 1 parking brake cable from the
parking brake intermediate lever.
(e) Remove the 2 bolts labeled A shown in the
illustration and separate the No. 1 parking brake
cable from the floor.
(f) Disconnect the connector from the parking brake
switch connector and remove the harness clamp
from the pedal bracket.
G028420E01
(g) Remove the 2 bolts, nut and parking brake pedal.
53. REMOVE NO. 1 PARKING BRAKE CABLE
ASSEMBLY (See page PB-16)
54. REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the screw and parking brake switch.
55. REMOVE PARKING PEDAL PAD
G028422E01
PB
PARKING BRAKE – PARKING BRAKE PEDAL
PB–9
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL PARKING PEDAL PAD
2.
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the parking brake switch with the screw.
3.
INSTALL NO. 1 PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSEMBLY
(See page PB-19)
4.
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE CONTROL PEDAL
ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the parking brake control pedal with the 2
bolts and nut.
Torque: 20 N*m (204 kgf*cm, 15 ft.*lbf)
(b) Connect the parking brake switch connector and
install the harness clamp to the pedal bracket.
G028422E01
Bolt A
(c) Connect the No. 1 parking brake cable to the
parking brake intermediate lever.
(d) Install the No. 1 parking brake cable on the floor
with the 2 bolts labeled A shown in the illustration.
Torque: 14 N*m (143 kgf*cm, 10 ft.*lbf)
G028420E01
(e) Install the No. 1 parking brake cable to the floor with
the clamp bolt.
Torque: 14 N*m (143 kgf*cm, 10 ft.*lbf)
(f) Install the 2 No. 1 parking brake cable clamp nuts
and a new parking brake front cable clamp.
Torque: 14 N*m (143 kgf*cm, 10 ft.*lbf)
G028419E01
PB
PB–10
PARKING BRAKE – PARKING BRAKE PEDAL
G028431E01
G028423E02
5.
INSTALL NO. 1 CONSOLE BOX MOUNTING
BRACKET
(a) Install the No. 1 front floor side reinforcement with
the 2 bolts.
(b) Install the No. 1 console box mounting bracket with
the 2 bolts.
6.
INSTALL YAW RATE SENSOR (w/ VSC) (See page
BC-224)
7.
INSTALL CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
(See page RS-307)
8.
INSTALL FRONT FLOOR FOOTREST (See page SR13)
9.
INSTALL FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY LH/RH
(a) Install the front seat LH/RH (see page SE-10).
10. INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL REINFORCEMENT
ASSEMBLY (See page AC-157)
11. INSTALL NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACE SUBASSEMBLY (See page AC-158)
12. FULLY TIGHTEN AIR CONDITIONING UNIT (See page
AC-158)
PB
13. INSTALL STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY (See page
SR-12)
14. INSTALL LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL SUBASSEMBLY (See page IP-20)
15. INSTALL SHIFT LEVER ASSEMBLY (See page HX126)
16. INSTALL POWER STEERING ECU (See page SR-17)
PARKING BRAKE – PARKING BRAKE PEDAL
PB–11
17. INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the instrument panel (see page IP-11).
HINT:
Refer to the procedures from the installation of the
instrument panel sub-assembly up until the
installation of the No. 1 instrument panel register
assembly.
18. INSTALL COOLER REFRIGERANT LIQUID PIPE E
(TO COOLER UNIT) (See page AC-159)
19. INSTALL SUCTION HOSE SUB-ASSEMBLY (See
page AC-160)
20. CHECK FOR REFRIGERANT LEAKAGE (See page
AC-142)
21. POSITION SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSEMBLY (See
page RS-279)
22. INSTALL STEERING COLUMN COVER (See page SR14)
23. INSTALL TILT LEVER BRACKET (See page SR-14)
24. INSTALL STEERING WHEEL ASSEMBLY (See page
SR-15)
25. INSTALL STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY (See page RS269)
26. INSPECT STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY (See page RS269)
27. CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
28. INSTALL REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
29. INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-8)
30. INSTALL REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
31. ADD ENGINE COOLANT
32. CHARGE REFRIGERANT (See page AC-141)
33. CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKAGE
34. WARM UP ENGINE
35. INSPECT AND ADJUST PARKING BRAKE PEDAL
TRAVEL
(a) Inspect and adjust the parking brake pedal travel
(see page PB-1).
36. CHECK SRS WARNING LIGHT
(a) Check the SRS warning light (see page RS-41).
37. PERFORM CALIBRATION
(a) Perform calibration (see page PS-13).
PB
PB–12
PARKING BRAKE – PARKING BRAKE PEDAL
38. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
PB
PB–12
PARKING BRAKE – PARKING BRAKE CABLE
PARKING BRAKE CABLE
PARKING BRAKE
BRAKE
COMPONENTS
FRONT FLOOR FOOTREST
PARKING BRAKE CONTROL PEDAL ASSEMBLY
20 (204, 15)
20 (204, 15)
NO. 1 WIRE
ADJUSTING NUT
CLIP
5.4 (55, 48 in.*lbf)
LOCK NUT
NO. 1 CONSOLE BOX
MOUNTING BRACKET
14 (143, 10)
NO. 1 FRONT FLOOR SIDE
REINFORCEMENT
14 (143, 10)
14 (143, 10)
PARKING BRAKE FRONT
CABLE CLAMP
NO. 1 PARKING BRAKE
CABLE ASSEMBLY
PB
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
PARKING BRAKE INTERMEDIATE
LEVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
Non-reusable part
C130374E02
PB–13
PARKING BRAKE – PARKING BRAKE CABLE
8 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
5.4 (55, 48 in.*lbf)
PARKING BRAKE
EQUALIZER
NO. 2 PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSEMBLY
5.4 (55, 48 in.*lbf)
5.4 (55, 48 in.*lbf)
5.4 (55, 48 in.*lbf)
CABLE
RETAINER
5.4 (55, 48 in.*lbf)
8 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
5.4 (55, 48 in.*lbf)
6 (61, 53 in.*lbf)
NO. 3 PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSEMBLY
PARKING BRAKE CABLE HEAT INSULATOR
5.4 (55, 48 in.*lbf)
PB
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C130375E01
PB–14
PARKING BRAKE – PARKING BRAKE CABLE
REMOVAL
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the No. 2 and No. 3 parking
brake cable assembly.
• The procedures listed below are for the No. 3 parking
brake cable assembly.
1.
DISCHARGE REFRIGERANT FROM
REFRIGERATION SYSTEM (See page AC-140)
2.
DISCONNECT SUCTION HOSE SUB-ASSEMBLY (See
page AC-146)
3.
DISCONNECT COOLER REFRIGERANT LIQUID PIPE
E (TO COOLER UNIT) (See page AC-146)
4.
DISCONNECT HEATER WATER HOSE B (See page
AC-146)
5.
DISCONNECT HEATER WATER HOSE A (See page
AC-146)
6.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page HB153)
7.
REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page HB153)
8.
REMOVE REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page HB153)
9.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
10. REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the instrument panel (see page IP-5).
HINT:
Refer to the procedures from the removal of the No.
1 instrument panel register assembly up until the
removal of the instrument panel sub-assembly.
11. REMOVE NO. 2 STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER
12. REMOVE NO. 3 STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER
13. REMOVE STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY (See page RS268)
PB
14. REMOVE STEERING WHEEL ASSEMBLY (See page
SR-8)
15. REMOVE TILT LEVER BRACKET (See page SR-8)
16. REMOVE STEERING COLUMN COVER (See page
SR-8)
17. REMOVE TURN SIGNAL SWITCH ASSEMBLY WITH
SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page SR-8)
PARKING BRAKE – PARKING BRAKE CABLE
PB–15
18. REMOVE FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH (See page
IR-7)
19. REMOVE FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH (See page
IR-7)
20. REMOVE COWL SIDE TRIM BOARD LH (See page IR7)
21. REMOVE COWL SIDE TRIM BOARD RH (See page
IR-7)
22. REMOVE CENTER INSTRUMENT CLUSTER FINISH
PANEL ASSEMBLY (See page IP-18)
23. REMOVE RADIO RECEIVER ASSEMBLY
24. REMOVE LOWER CENTER INSTRUMENT PANEL
FINISH PANEL (See page IP-18)
25. REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR LOCK
COVER (See page IP-18)
26. REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR LOCK
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-18)
27. REMOVE LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH
PANEL (See page IP-19)
28. REMOVE NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL UNDER
COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page IP-19)
29. REMOVE POWER STEERING ECU (See page SR-17)
30. REMOVE SHIFT LEVER ASSEMBLY (See page HX124)
31. REMOVE REAR NO. 3 AIR DUCT (See page AC-147)
32. REMOVE NO. 3 HEATER TO REGISTER DUCT (See
page AC-147)
33. REMOVE NO. 1 HEATER TO REGISTER DUCT (See
page AC-147)
34. REMOVE NO. 2 HEATER TO REGISTER DUCT (See
page AC-147)
35. REMOVE DEFROSTER NOZZLE ASSEMBLY (See
page AC-148)
36. REMOVE ECM (See page ES-469)
37. REMOVE HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU (See
page HV-543)
38. REMOVE NETWORK GATEWAY ECU
39. REMOVE NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACE SUBASSEMBLY (See page AC-148)
40. REMOVE AIR CONDITIONING AMPLIFIER
ASSEMBLY (See page AC-179)
41. REMOVE STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY (See page
SR-11)
PB
PB–16
PARKING BRAKE – PARKING BRAKE CABLE
42. REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL REINFORCEMENT
ASSEMBLY (See page AC-148)
43. REMOVE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY LH/RH
(a) Remove the front seat LH/RH (see page SE-4).
44. REMOVE UPPER CONSOLE PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
(See page IP-24)
45. REMOVE CONSOLE BOX POCKET
46. REMOVE CONSOLE BOX CARPET
47. REMOVE REAR CONSOLE BOX SUB-ASSEMBLY
(See page IP-24)
48. REMOVE FRONT FLOOR FOOTREST (See page SR10)
49. REMOVE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
(See page RS-306)
50. REMOVE YAW RATE SENSOR (w/ VSC) (See page
BC-224)
51. REMOVE NO. 1 CONSOLE BOX MOUNTING
BRACKET (See page PB-7)
52. REMOVE PARKING BRAKE CONTROL PEDAL
ASSEMBLY (See page PB-7)
53. REMOVE NO. 1 PARKING BRAKE CABLE
ASSEMBLY
(a) Unbend the parking brake pedal claw.
(b) Remove the lock nut and adjusting nut of the No. 1
parking brake cable from the parking brake pedal.
(c) Disengage the clip and remove the No. 1 parking
brake cable from the parking brake pedal.
54. REMOVE REAR WHEEL
G028424E01
55. REMOVE REAR BRAKE DRUM SUB-ASSEMBLY (See
page BR-47)
56. SEPARATE PARKING BRAKE SHOE STRUT SET LH
(See page BR-47)
57. REMOVE FRONT BRAKE SHOE (See page BR-47)
58. REMOVE PARKING BRAKE SHOE STRUT SET LH
(See page BR-47)
59. REMOVE REAR BRAKE AUTOMATIC ADJUST
LEVER LH (See page BR-48)
PB
60. REMOVE REAR BRAKE SHOE (See page BR-48)
61. REMOVE REAR BRAKE PARKING BRAKE SHOE
LEVER SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page BR-48)
62. REMOVE HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (See page EC50)
63. REMOVE FRONT FLOOR PANEL BRACE (See page
EX-2)
PB–17
PARKING BRAKE – PARKING BRAKE CABLE
64. REMOVE FRONT EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY (See
page EX-2)
65. REMOVE PARKING BRAKE CABLE HEAT
INSULATOR
(a) Remove the 2 nuts and separate the parking brake
cable heat insulator.
66. REMOVE NO. 3 PARKING BRAKE CABLE
ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the bolt and No. 3 parking brake cable from
the backing plate.
(b) Remove the bolts, button and No. 3 parking brake
cable.
G029315E01
Bolt
Bolt
Bolt
Button
Bolt
G028425E01
(c) Disconnect the No. 3 parking brake cable from the
parking brake equalizer.
PB
PB–18
PARKING BRAKE – PARKING BRAKE CABLE
INSTALLATION
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the No. 2 and No. 3 parking
brake cable assembly.
• The procedures listed below are for the No. 3 parking
brake cable assembly.
1.
INSTALL NO. 3 PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSEMBLY
(a) Connect the No. 3 parking brake cable to the
parking brake equalizer.
(b) Install the No. 3 parking brake cable with the bolts
and button.
Torque: 5.4 N*m (55 kgf*cm, 48 in.*lbf) (Bolt A)
6.0 N*m (61 kgf*cm, 53 in.*lbf) (Bolt B)
Bolt A
Bolt A
Bolt B
Button
Bolt A
G028425E02
(c) Install the No. 3 parking brake cable to the backing
plate with the bolt.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
G029315E01
PB
2.
INSTALL PARKING BRAKE CABLE HEAT
INSULATOR
(a) Install the parking brake heat insulator with the 2
nuts.
Torque: 5.4 N*m (55 kgf*cm, 48 in.*lbf)
3.
INSTALL FRONT EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY (See
page EX-3)
4.
INSTALL FRONT FLOOR PANEL BRACE (See page
EX-4)
5.
INSTALL HEATED OXYGEN SENSOR (See page EC51)
6.
APPLY HIGH TEMPERATURE GREASE (See page
BR-50)
PARKING BRAKE – PARKING BRAKE CABLE
PB–19
7.
INSTALL REAR BRAKE PARKING BRAKE SHOE
LEVER SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page BR-50)
8.
INSTALL REAR BRAKE SHOE (See page BR-51)
9.
INSTALL REAR BRAKE SHOE RETURN SPRING (See
page BR-51)
10. INSTALL REAR BRAKE AUTOMATIC ADJUST
LEVER LH (See page BR-51)
11. INSTALL PARKING BRAKE SHOE STRUT SET LH
(See page BR-51)
12. INSTALL FRONT BRAKE SHOE (See page BR-52)
13. CONNECT PARKING BRAKE SHOE STRUT SET LH
(See page BR-52)
14. CHECK REAR DRUM BRAKE INSTALLATION (See
page BR-52)
15. INSTALL REAR BRAKE DRUM SUB-ASSEMBLY (See
page BR-53)
16. ADJUST REAR DRUM BRAKE SHOE CLEARANCE
(See page BR-53)
17. INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 103 N*m (1,050 kgf*cm, 76 ft.*lbf)
18. INSPECT AND ADJUST PARKING BRAKE PEDAL
TRAVEL
(a) Inspect and adjust the parking brake pedal travel
(see page PB-1).
19. CHECK FOR EXHAUST GAS LEAKAGE (See page
EX-4)
G028424E01
20. INSTALL NO. 1 PARKING BRAKE CABLE ASSEMBLY
(a) Pass the No. 1 parking brake cable through the
pedal bracket and hold it with a new clip.
(b) Pass the parking brake cable through the pedal
guide. Temporarily tighten the adjusting nut and lock
nut.
HINT:
Fully tighten the adjusting nut and lock nut when
adjusting the parking brake pedal free play.
(c) Bend the parking brake pedal claw fully.
21. INSTALL PARKING BRAKE CONTROL PEDAL
ASSEMBLY (See page PB-8)
22. INSTALL NO. 1 CONSOLE BOX MOUNTING
BRACKET (See page PB-9)
23. INSTALL YAW RATE SENSOR (w/ VSC) (See page
BC-224)
24. INSTALL CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
(See page RS-307)
25. INSTALL FRONT FLOOR FOOTREST (See page SR13)
PB
PB–20
PARKING BRAKE – PARKING BRAKE CABLE
26. INSTALL FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY LH/RH
(a) Install the front seat LH/RH (see page SE-10).
27. INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL REINFORCEMENT
ASSEMBLY (See page AC-157)
28. INSTALL NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL BRACE SUBASSEMBLY (See page AC-158)
29. FULLY TIGHTEN AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
ASSEMBLY (See page AC-158)
30. INSTALL STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY (See page
SR-12)
31. INSTALL LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL SUBASSEMBLY (See page IP-20)
32. INSTALL SHIFT LEVER ASSEMBLY (See page HX126)
33. INSTALL POWER STEERING ECU (See page SR-17)
34. INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the instrument panel (see page IP-11).
HINT:
Refer to the procedures from the installation of the
instrument panel sub-assembly up until the
installation of the No. 1 instrument panel register
assembly.
35. INSTALL COOLER REFRIGERANT LIQUID PIPE E
(TO COOLER UNIT) (See page AC-159)
36. INSTALL SUCTION HOSE SUB-ASSEMBLY (See
page AC-160)
37. CHECK FOR REFRIGERANT LEAKAGE (See page
AC-142)
38. POSITION SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSEMBLY (See
page RS-279)
39. INSTALL STEERING COLUMN COVER (See page SR14)
40. INSTALL TILT LEVER BRACKET (See page SR-14)
41. INSTALL STEERING WHEEL ASSEMBLY (See page
SR-15)
42. INSTALL STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY (See page RS269)
PB
43. INSPECT STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY (See page RS269)
44. CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
45. INSTALL REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
46. INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-8)
PARKING BRAKE – PARKING BRAKE CABLE
PB–21
47. INSTALL REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
48. ADD ENGINE COOLANT
49. CHARGE REFRIGERANT (See page AC-141)
50. CHECK FOR ENGINE COOLANT LEAKAGE
51. WARM UP ENGINE
52. INSPECT AND ADJUST PARKING BRAKE PEDAL
TRAVEL
(a) Inspect and adjust the parking brake pedal travel
(see page PB-1).
53. CHECK SRS WARNING LIGHT
(a) Check the SRS warning light (see page RS-41).
54. PERFORM TORQUE SENSOR ZERO POINT
CALIBRATION
(a) Perform the torque sensor zero point calibration
(see page PS-13).
55. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
PB
PARK ASSIST / MONITORING – REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM
PM–1
REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
NOTICE:
When disconnecting the cable from the negative (-)
battery terminal, initialize the following systems after the
cable is reconnected.
System Name
Power Window Control System
See procedure
IN-32
PM
PM–2
PARK ASSIST / MONITORING – REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
ENGINE ROOM RELAY BLOCK
- INTEGRATION RELAY (UNIT C: BK/UP LP RELAY)
PM
B128129E02
PARK ASSIST / MONITORING – REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM
PM–3
MULTI-DISPLAY
PM
TELEVISION CAMERA
E128797E02
PM–4
PARK ASSIST / MONITORING – REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
Multi-display
Television Camera
BK/UP LP
from
GAUGE Fuse
PM
to
Combination Meter
E126419E02
PARK ASSIST / MONITORING – REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM
PM–5
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
2.
Item
GENERAL
(a) To assist the driver with parking the vehicle by
displaying an image of the area behind the vehicle,
this system has a television camera mounted on the
luggage compartment door. The system displays
the image on the multi-display.
(b) This system consists of the following components:
(1) Multi-display
(2) Television camera
(c) This system is equipped with a self-diagnosis
system, which is operated on a designated window
that appears on the display panel, just as in the
navigation system.
FUNCTION OF COMPONENTS
(a) The multi-display controls the system by using
information from the following components:
Function
•
Television Camera Assembly
•
•
•
Multi-display
•
BK/UP LP Relay
Mounted on luggage compartment door to transmit an image of
area behind vehicle to multi-display.
Color video camera that uses CCD (Charge Coupled Device) and
wide-angle lens.
Receives video signals, which contain an image of area behind
vehicle taken with television camera assembly.
Multi-display effects control of system by receiving shift position
signal from BK/UP LP relay.
Displays rear view monitor image on display panel.
Transmits a reverse shift position signal to multi-display.
3.
4.
OPERATION EXPLANATION
(a) The BK/UP LP relay sends an R position signal to
the multi-display when the shift lever is moved to the
R position. After receiving the R position signal, the
multi-display switches from the navigation system to
the rear view monitor system.
NOTES FOR REAR VIEW MONITOR
(a) Notes for the rear view monitor.
(1) The rear view monitor may not function properly
if subjected to a severe impact by any hard
object.
(2) Do not "scrub" the lens of the camera because it
is made of resin. Scrubbing it may scratch the
cover and affect the image. Prevent organic
solvents, waxes, bond removing solvents, or
glass coating from adhering to the cover. If
anything adheres to the cover, clean it off
immediately and wash the lens with water.
(3) Exposing the camera to a sudden temperature
change may affect proper functioning of the
camera.
(4) A clear image may not appear if the camera is
dirty with snow, mud, etc. In that case, wash it
with water and wipe off the lens. Use a detergent
to remove dirt if necessary.
PM
PM–6
PARK ASSIST / MONITORING – REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM
(b) Images are difficult to discern even in normal
conditions if:
(1) The camera lens is frosted over (the image
immediately after turning the power switch ON
(IG) may be blurred or darker than normal).
(2) A strong beam of light, such as a sunbeam or
headlight, hits the camera.
(3) It is too dark around the camera (at night, etc.).
(4) The ambient temperature around the camera is
either too high or too low.
HINT:
When a strong light, such as a sunbeam
reflected off the vehicle's body, hits the camera,
the image may be blurred. This is called the
"SMEAR" phenomenon, peculiar to the CCD
camera.
PM
PARK ASSIST / MONITORING – REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM
PM–7
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
Use theses procedures to troubleshoot the rear view monitor
system.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
INSPECT BATTERY VOLTAGE
Standard voltage:
11 to 14 V
If the voltage is below 11 V, recharge or replace the battery
before proceeding.
NEXT
3
CHECK CAMERA LENS
(a) Check that the camera lens is not dirty with mud, foreign
matter, etc.
NEXT
4
BASIC INSPECTION
(a) Turn the power switch ON (ACC).
(b) Check whether or not the display appears on the multidisplay.
Result
Result
Proceed to
Display appears
A
Display does not appear
B
B
Go to NAVIGATION SYSTEM
A
5
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Result
Result
Proceed to
Fault is not listed in problem symptoms
table
A
Fault is listed in problem symptoms
table
B
PM
PM–8
PARK ASSIST / MONITORING – REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM
B
Go to step 7
A
6
OVERALL ANALYSIS AND TROUBLESHOOTING
(a) Terminals of ECU (see page PM-8)
NEXT
7
NEXT
END
PM
ADJUST, REPAIR OR REPLACE
PM–9
PARK ASSIST / MONITORING – REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
Use the table below to help determine the cause of the
problem symptom. The potential causes of the symptoms are
listed in order of probability in the "Suspected area" column of
the table. Check each symptom by checking the suspected
areas in the order they are listed. Replace parts as
necessary.
Symptom
When shift lever is in R position, rear view monitor
image is not displayed (Screen is not black).
When shift lever is in R position, rear view monitor
image is not displayed (Screen is black).
When shift lever is not in R position, rear view monitor
image is displayed.
Problem with the rear view monitor image (color,
disorder of picture).
Suspected area
See page
1. Reverse signal circuit
PM-9
2. Proceed to "Display Signal Circuit between Multi-display
and Television Camera Assembly"
PM-12
3. Multi-display
-
1. Multi-display power source circuit
AV-175
2. Proceed to "Display Signal Circuit between Multi-display
and Television Camera Assembly"
PM-12
3. Multi-display
-
4. Television camera assembly
-
1. Reverse signal circuit
PM-9
2. Multi-display
-
1. Proceed to "Display Signal Circuit between Multi-display
and Television Camera Assembly"
PM-12
2. Multi-display
-
3. Television camera assembly
-
PM
PM–10
PARK ASSIST / MONITORING – REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
CHECK TELEVISION CAMERA ASSEMBLY
T12
E126420E01
(a) Disconnect the T12 camera connector.
(b) Measure the voltage and resistance between each
terminal of the wire harness side connector.
PM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal
Description
Condition
Specified Condition
CGND (T12-3) - Body ground
W - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
CB+ (T12-4) - CGND (T12-3)
B-W
Power source
Power switch ON (IG), shift lever R
position
Approx. 6 V
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
(c) Reconnect the T12 camera connector.
(d) Measure the voltage and frequency between each
terminal of the connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal
Description
Condition
Specified Condition
CV+ (T12-2) - CV- (T12-1)
R - Shielded
Display signal
Power switch ON (IG), shift lever R
position
See waveform 1
If the result is not as specified, the camera may
have a malfunction.
(e) Using an oscilloscope, check the waveform
Waveform 1
GND
Item
Content
Symbols (Terminal No.)
CV+ (T12-2) - CV- (T12-1)
Tool Setting
0.2 V/DIV., 0.2 µsec./DIV.
Condition
Power switch ON (IG), shift lever R
position
2.
E119731E01
CHECK MULTI-DISPLAY (See page AV-31)
PM–11
PARK ASSIST / MONITORING – REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM
Reverse Signal Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The multi-display receives a reverse signal from the BK/UP LP relay (engine room relay block).
WIRING DIAGRAM
Multi-display
to
Rear Combination Lights
BK/UP LP
from
GAUGE Fuse
REV
PM
to
Combination Meter
E126421E04
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK BACK-UP LIGHT
(a) Move the shift lever to the R position and check if the
back-up light comes on.
OK:
The back-up light comes on.
NG
OK
GO TO LIGHTING SYSTEM
PM–12
2
PARK ASSIST / MONITORING – REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM
CHECK VEHICLE SIGNAL (DISPLAY CHECK MODE)
(a) Enter the "Display Check" mode (Vehicle Signal Check
Mode) (see page PM-12).
(b) Check that the display changes between ON and OFF
according to the shift lever operation (P and R).
OK
Shift Lever Position
E119736
Display
R
ON
Except R
OFF
HINT:
This display is updated once per second. As a result, it is
normal for the display to lag behind the actual change in
the switch.
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION
PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM
SYMPTOMS TABLE
NG
3
CHECK MULTI-DISPLAY
PM
(a) Disconnect the M13 display connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the display.
Standard voltage
M13
REV
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
M13-21 (REV) - Body
ground
Power switch is ON
(IG).
Shift lever is moved to
R position.
10 to 14 V
M13-21 (REV) - Body
ground
Power switch is ON
(IG).
Shift lever is moved to
any position except R.
Below 1 V
E126484E02
OK
NG
REPLACE MULTI DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
PARK ASSIST / MONITORING – REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM
4
PM–13
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (MULTI-DISPLAY - ENGINE ROOM RELAY BLOCK (BK/UP LP
RELAY))
(a) Disconnect the M13 display connector.
(b) Disconnect the 3H relay block connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Multi-display
M13
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
M13-21 (REV) - 3H-8
Below 1 Ω
M13-21 (REV) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REV
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
Engine Room Relay Block
3H
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
17 18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32
E126422E04
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
PM
PM–14
PARK ASSIST / MONITORING – REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM
Display Signal Circuit between Multi-display and Television Camera
Assembly
DESCRIPTION
This is the display signal circuit of the television camera.
WIRING DIAGRAM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
Television Camera
Multi-display
CV+
V+
CGND
CGND
CB+
PM
CA+
CV-
Shielded
V-
Shielded
I102047E02
1
CHECK TELEVISION CAMERA ASSEMBLY
(a) Check the waveform of the camera using an
oscilloscope.
OK:
Waveform is as shown in the illustration.
T12
CV+
CV-
E126485E01
Item
Content
Tester Connection
CV+ (T12-2) - CV- (T12-1)
Tool Setting
0.2 V/DIV., 0.2 µsec./DIV.
Condition
Power switch ON (IG), shift lever R
position
PARK ASSIST / MONITORING – REAR VIEW MONITOR SYSTEM
NG
PM–15
REPAIR TELEVISION CAMERA ASSEMBLY
GND
E119731E02
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (MULTI-DISPLAY - TELEVISION CAMERA)
(a) Disconnect the M14 display connector.
(b) Disconnect the T12 camera connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Multi-display
M14
Tester Connection
V+
V-
CA+
CGND
Television Camera
CV+
CV-
CB+
M14-29 (CA+) - T12-4 (CB+)
Below 1 Ω
M14-30 (CGND) - T12-3 (CGND)
Below 1 Ω
M14-27 (V+) - T12-2 (CV+)
Below 1 Ω
M14-28 (V-) - T12-1 (CV-)
Below 1 Ω
M14-29 (CA+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
M14-27 (V+) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
M14-28 (V-) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
T12
Specified Condition
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
CGND
E126424E03
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT INSPECTION PROCEDURE SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
PM
PREPARATION – 1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
PP–1
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09070-20010
Moulding Remover
-
09082-00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
-
Test Lead Set
-
(09083-00150)
PP
PP–2
PREPARATION – 1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
EQUIPMENT
19 mm deep socket wrench
PP
-
Ohmmeter
-
Radiator cap tester
-
Service wire harness
-
Torque wrench
-
PP–2
PREPARATION – 1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL
PREPARATION
SST
PP
09011-38121
12 mm Socket Wrench for 12
Pointed Head
-
09023-38400
Union Nut Wrench 14mm
-
09032-00100
Oil Pan Seal Cutter
-
09201-10000
Valve Guide Bushing Remover &
Replacer Set
-
(09201-01050)
Valve Guide Bushing Remover &
Replacer 5
-
09201-41020
Valve Stem Oil Seal Replacer
-
09202-70020
Valve Spring Compressor
-
(09202-00010)
Attachment
-
(09202-01010)
Arm
-
(09202-01020)
Set Bolt
-
Cylinder Head Bolt Wrench
-
09205-16010
PREPARATION – 1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL
09213-58012
Crankshaft Pulley Holding Tool
-
(91111-50845)
Bolt
-
PP–3
PP
09213-58013
Crankshaft Pulley Holding Tool
-
(91111-50845)
Bolt
-
09221-25026
Piston Pin Remover & Replacer
-
(09221-00021)
Body
-
(09221-00030)
Spring
-
(09221-00141)
Guide H
-
(09221-00150)
Bushing D
-
(09221-00190)
Guide K
-
09223-22010
Crankshaft Front Oil Seal
Replacer
-
09223-56010
Crankshaft Rear Oil Seal
Replacer
-
PP–4
PREPARATION – 1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL
09228-06501
Oil Filter Wrench
-
09301-00210
Clutch Guide Tool
-
09330-00021
Companion Flange Holding Tool
-
09950-50013
Puller C Set
-
(09951-05010)
Hanger 150
-
(09952-05010)
Slide Arm
-
(09953-05020)
Center Bolt 150
-
(09954-05021)
Claw No.2
-
09950-60010
Replacer Set
-
(09951-00180)
Replacer 18
-
(09951-00250)
Replacer 25
-
(09951-00380)
Replacer 38
-
PP
PREPARATION – 1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL
(09952-06010)
09950-70010
Adapter
-
Handle Set
-
PP–5
PP
(09951-07100)
Handle 100
-
Variable Pin Wrench Set
-
(09962-01000)
Variable Pin Wrench Arm Assembly
-
(09963-00600)
Pin 6
-
Compression Gauge Attachment
-
09960-10010
09992-00500
PP–6
PREPARATION – 1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09043-50080
Bi-hexagon Wrench 8 mm
-
(09043-20060)
Socket Hexagon Wrench 6
-
(09043-20080)
Socket Hexagon Wrench 8
-
(09043-20100)
Socket Hexagon Wrench 10
-
(09043-20120)
Socket Hexagon Wrench 12
-
Engine Sling Device
-
PP
09090-04020
PREPARATION – 1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL
PP–7
EQUIPMENT
Alignment tester
-
Angle gauge
-
Bar (width 2 - 3 mm)
-
Belt tension gauge
-
Caliper gauge
-
Chain Block
-
CO/HC meter
-
Compression gauge
-
Connecting rod aligner
-
Cylinder gauge
-
Dial indicator with magnetic base
-
Feeler gauge
-
Heater
-
Intelligent tester
-
Micrometer
-
Piston ring compressor
-
Piston ring expander
-
Plastic Hammer
-
Plastigage
-
Precision straight edge
-
Radiator cap tester
-
Reamer
-
Slide calipers
-
Spring tension gauge
-
Spring tester
-
Steel square
-
Sandpaper (#400)
-
Tachometer
-
Timing light
-
Tire pressure gauge
-
Toe-in gauge
-
Torque wrench
-
Universal engine lifter
-
Valve seat cutter
-
V-block
-
Vernier calipers
-
Wooden block
-
PP
PP–8
PREPARATION – 1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL
SSM
PP
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three Bond 1207B or Equivalent
-
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing 1282B, Three Bond 1282B or
Equivalent
-
Toyota Genuine Adhesive 1324, Three Bond 1324 or Equivalent
-
Toyota Genuine Adhesive 1344, Three Bond 1344 or Equivalent
-
PP–8
PREPARATION – 1NZ-FXE FUEL
1NZ-FXE FUEL
PREPARATION
SST
PP
09268-41047
Injection Measuring Tool Set
-
(09268-41110)
Adaptor
-
(09268-41300)
Clamp
-
(95336-08070)
Hose
-
EFI Fuel Pressure Gauge
-
(09268-41200)
Gauge
-
(09268-41220)
Hose
-
(09268-41250)
T Joint
-
Wire H EFI Inspection
-
09268-45014
09842-30080
PP–9
PREPARATION – 1NZ-FXE FUEL
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082-00040
(09083-00150)
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
-
Test Lead Set
-
PP
PP–10
PREPARATION – 1NZ-FXE FUEL
EQUIPMENT
PP
Clip
-
Cutter knife
-
Graduated cylinder
-
Ohmmeter
-
Plastic-faced hammer
-
Service wire harness
-
Stop watch
-
Torque wrench
-
Vernier calipers
-
Plastic bag
-
Voltmeter
-
Wire brush
-
Wooden block
-
PREPARATION – 1NZ-FXE FUEL
PP–11
SSM
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Block, Three Bond 1207B or Equivalent
-
PP
PP–10
PREPARATION – 1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL
PREPARATION
SST
09224-00010
PP
O2 Sensor Wrench
-
PREPARATION – 1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL
PP–11
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09042-00010
Torx Socket T30
-
09082-00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
-
PP
(09083-00150)
Test Lead Set
-
PP–12
PREPARATION – 1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL
EQUIPMENT
Hose
PP
-
Ohmmeter
-
Service wire harness
-
Torque wrench
-
Vernier calipers
-
Voltmeter
-
PREPARATION – 1NZ-FXE EXHAUST
PP–11
1NZ-FXE EXHAUST
PREPARATION
EQUIPMENT
Plastic-faced hammer
-
Torque wrench
-
Vernier caliper
-
Wooden block
-
PP
PP–12
PREPARATION – 1NZ-FXE COOLING
1NZ-FXE COOLING
PREPARATION
SST
PP
09817-33190
Sensor Socket Wrench
-
09960-10010
Variable Pin Wrench Set
-
(09962-01000)
Variable Pin Wrench Arm Assembly
-
(09963-00600)
Pin 6
-
PP–13
PREPARATION – 1NZ-FXE COOLING
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082-00040
(09083-00150)
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
-
Test Lead Set
-
PP
09216-00021
(09043-20060)
Belt Tension Gauge
-
Socket Hexagon Wrench 6
-
PP–14
PREPARATION – 1NZ-FXE COOLING
EQUIPMENT
Radiator cap tester
PP
-
Thermometer
-
Torque wrench
-
Slide calipers
-
Heater
-
PREPARATION – 1NZ-FXE COOLING
PP–15
COOLANT
Item
Capacity
Classification
Engine coolant
8.6 liters (9.1 US pts, 7.6 Imp. qts)
Use only "TOYOTA Super Long Life Coolant"
or similar high quality ethylene glycol based
non-silicate, non-amine, non-nitrite, and nonborate coolant with long-life hybrid organic
acid technology (coolant with long-life hybrid
organic acid technology consists of a
combination of low phosphates and organic
acids)
PP
PP–14
PREPARATION – 1NZ-FXE LUBRICATION
1NZ-FXE LUBRICATION
PREPARATION
SST
PP
09213-58013
Crankshaft Pulley Holding Tool
-
(91111-50845)
Bolt
-
09228-06501
Oil Filter Wrench
-
09330-00021
Companion Flange Holding Tool
-
09950-50013
Puller C Set
-
(09951-05010)
Hanger 150
-
(09952-05010)
Slide Arm
-
(09953-05020)
Center Bolt 150
-
(09954-05021)
Claw No.2
-
09950-60010
Replacer Set
-
(09951-00250)
Replacer 25
-
PP–15
PREPARATION – 1NZ-FXE LUBRICATION
(09951-00380)
Replacer 38
-
(09952-06010)
Adapter
-
PP
09950-70010
Handle Set
-
(09951-07100)
Handle 100
-
PP–16
PREPARATION – 1NZ-FXE LUBRICATION
EQUIPMENT
PP
Belt tension gauge
-
Feeler gauge
-
Precision straight edge
-
Radiator cap tester
-
Torque wrench
-
Wooden block
-
PP–17
PREPARATION – 1NZ-FXE LUBRICATION
LUBRICANT
Item
Capacity
Classification
Oil grade
-
API grade SL, EnergyConserving or ILSAC, multi-grade
engine oil
w/ oil filter change
3.7 liters (3.9 US qts, 3.3 lmp. qts)
-
w/o oil filter change
3.4 liters (3.6 US qts, 3.0 lmp. qts)
Drain and refill
Dry fill
4.1 liters (4.3 US qts, 3.6 lmp. qts)
-
PP
PP–18
PREPARATION – 1NZ-FXE LUBRICATION
SSM
PP
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing Black, Three Bond 1207B or Equivalent
-
Toyota Genuine Seal Packing 1282B, Three Bond 1282B or
Equivalent
-
PP–16
PREPARATION – 1NZ-FXE IGNITION
1NZ-FXE IGNITION
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082-00040
PP
(09083-00150)
09200-00010
(09857-00031)
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
-
Test Lead Set
-
Engine Adjust Kit
-
Spark Plug Gap Gauge
-
PREPARATION – 1NZ-FXE IGNITION
PP–17
EQUIPMENT
Torque wrench
-
Spark plug cleaner
-
Stop watch
-
PP
PREPARATION – 1NZ-FXE STARTING
PP–17
1NZ-FXE STARTING
PREPARATION
EQUIPMENT
Ohmmeter
-
PP
PP–18
PREPARATION – 1NZ-FXE CHARGING
1NZ-FXE CHARGING
PREPARATION
EQUIPMENT
Torque wrench
PP
-
PREPARATION – P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL
PP–19
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09042-00010
Torx Socket T30
-
PP
PP–20
PREPARATION – P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL
EQUIPMENT
PP
Ohmmeter
-
Radiator cap tester
-
Stopwatch
-
Thermometer
-
Torque wrench
-
Voltmeter
-
PP–20
PREPARATION – P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL
PREPARATION
EQUIPMENT
PP
Stopwatch
-
Ohmmeter
-
Torque wrench
-
Voltmeter
-
PP–21
PREPARATION – HYBRID TRANSAXLE
HYBRID TRANSAXLE
PREPARATION
SST
09308-00010
Oil Seal Puller
-
09350-32014
TOYOTA Automatic Transmission
Tool Set
-
(09351-32130)
Handle
-
(09351-32150)
Oil Seal Replacer
-
09388-40010
Input Oil Seal Replacer
-
09527-10011
Rear Axle Shaft Bearing Remover
-
09564-32011
Differential Preload Adaptor
-
09608-06041
Front Hub Inner Bearing Cone
Replacer
-
09612-30012
Steering Worm Bearing Puller
-
09710-22021
Front Suspension Bushing Tool
Set
-
Upper Arm Bushing Replacer
-
(09710-01031)
PP
PP–22
PREPARATION – HYBRID TRANSAXLE
09950-00020
Bearing Remover
-
09950-40011
Puller B Set
-
(09951-04010)
Hanger 150
-
(09952-04010)
Slide Arm
-
(09953-04020)
Center Bolt 150
-
(09954-04010)
Arm 25
-
(09955-04061)
Claw No.6
-
(09958-04010)
Holder (J)
-
09950-60010
Replacer Set
-
(09951-00330)
Replacer 33
-
(09951-00360)
Replacer 36
-
(09951-00370)
Replacer 37
-
PP
PP–23
PREPARATION – HYBRID TRANSAXLE
(09951-00460)
09950-60020
Replacer 46
-
Replacer Set No.2
-
PP
(09951-00680)
Replacer 68
-
09950-70010
Handle Set
-
(09951-07100)
Handle 100
-
(09951-07200)
Handle 200
-
09992-00095
Automatic Transmission Oil
Pressure Gauge Set
-
(09992-00112)
Adaptor A
-
(09992-00271)
Gauge Assembly
-
PP–24
PREPARATION – HYBRID TRANSAXLE
EQUIPMENT
Straightedge
PP
-
Vernier calipers
-
Dial indicator or dial indicator with magnetic base
-
Torque wrench
-
Feeler gauge
-
Plastic-faced hammer
-
Press
-
Punch
-
PREPARATION – HYBRID TRANSAXLE
PP–25
LUBRICANT
Hybrid transaxle oil
3.8 liter (4.0 US qts, 3.3 Imp.qts)
Toyota Genuine ATF WS
PP
PP–26
PREPARATION – HYBRID TRANSAXLE
SSM
Toyota Genuine Adhesive 1344
Three Bond 1344 or Equivalent
PP
-
PP–25
PREPARATION – DRIVE SHAFT
DRIVE SHAFT
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09011-12301
Socket Wrench 30 mm
-
09905-00012
Snap Ring No.1 Expander
-
PP
PP–26
EQUIPMENT
Torque wrench
Dial indicator with magnetic base
Alignment tester
Toe-in gauge
Angle gauge
PP
PREPARATION – DRIVE SHAFT
PREPARATION – DRIVE SHAFT
PP–27
LUBRICANT
Item
Capacity
Front drive shaft
Outboard joint grease
Inboard joint grease
125 to 135 g (4.9 to 5.3 oz.)
125 to 135 g (4.9 to 5.3 oz.)
PP
PP–26
PREPARATION – AXLE
AXLE
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09011-12301
PP
Socket Wrench 30 mm
-
PREPARATION – AXLE
PP–27
EQUIPMENT
Torque wrench
Dial indicator with magnetic base
Alignment tester
Toe-in gauge
Angle gauge
PP
PP–27
PREPARATION – SUSPENSION
SUSPENSION
PREPARATION
SST
09023-00101
Union Nut Wrench 10 mm
-
09611-36020
Tie Rod End Puller
-
09710-04101
Base
-
09727-30021
Coil Spring Compressor
-
(09727-00010)
Bolt Set
-
(09727-00021)
Arm Set
-
(09727-00031)
Compressor
-
09729-22031
Front Spring Upper Seat Holder
-
09950-40011
Puller B Set
-
(09951-04020)
Hanger 200
-
(09952-04010)
Slide Arm
-
PP
PP–28
PREPARATION – SUSPENSION
(09953-04030)
Center Bolt 200
-
(09954-04020)
Arm 100
-
(09955-04051)
Claw No.5
-
(09957-04010)
Attachment
-
(09958-04011)
Holder
-
09950-60010
Replacer Set
-
(09951-00620)
Replacer 62
-
(09951-00630)
Replacer 63
-
PP
PP–29
PREPARATION – SUSPENSION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09011-12301
Socket Wrench 30 mm
-
09040-00011
Hexagon Wrench Set
-
PP
(09043-20060)
Socket Hexagon Wrench 6
-
PP–30
PREPARATION – SUSPENSION
EQUIPMENT
Alignment tester
Angle gauge
Camber-caster-kingpin gauge
Dial indicator with magnetic base
Drill (Safety equipment: epotective goggles, etc.)
PP
Slide Calipers
Tire pressure gauge
Torque wrench
Toe-in gauge
Shock absorber disposal
PP–30
PREPARATION – TIRE AND WHEEL
TIRE AND WHEEL
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082-00040
PP
(09083-00150)
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
-
Test Lead Set
-
PREPARATION – TIRE AND WHEEL
PP–31
EQUIPMENT
Dial indicator with magnetic base
Tire pressure gauge
Torque wrench
Wheel balancer
PP
PP–31
PREPARATION – BRAKE CONTROL
BRAKE CONTROL
PREPARATION
SST
09023-00101
Union Nut Wrench 10 mm
-
09214-76011
Crankshaft Pulley Replacer
-
09520-00031
Rear Axle Shaft Puller
-
Shocker
-
09521-00020
Drive Shaft Boot Clamping Tool
-
09709-29018
LSPV Gauge Set
-
09950-00020
Bearing Remover
-
(09520-00040)
PP
PP–32
PREPARATION – BRAKE CONTROL
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
PP
09042-00010
Torx Socket T30
•
•
•
Brake actuator assembly
Skid control ECU
Steering angle sensor
(09060-20010)
Socket Wrench
•
•
Skid control ECU
Steering angle sensor
PREPARATION – BRAKE CONTROL
PP–33
EQUIPMENT
Torque wrench
Voltmeter
Drill
Slide calipers
Pedal effort gauge
PP
PP–34
PREPARATION – BRAKE CONTROL
LUBRICANT
PP
Item
Capacity
Classification
Brake fluid
-
SAE J1703 or FMVSS No. 116 DOT3
PP–33
PREPARATION – BRAKE
BRAKE
PREPARATION
SST
09023-00100
Union Nut Wrench 10 mm
-
09023-00101
Union Nut Wrench 10 mm
-
09703-30011
Tool Set, Brake Shoe Return
Spring
-
09718-00010
Shoe Hold Down Spring Driver
-
PP
PP–34
PREPARATION – BRAKE
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09042-00010
PP
Torx Socket T30
Brake Master Cylinder Sub-assembly
PREPARATION – BRAKE
PP–35
EQUIPMENT
Stopwatch
Dial indicator
Radiator cap tester
Torque wrench
Voltmeter
Dial indicator with magnetic base
Tire pressure gauge
Alignment tester
Toe-in gauge
Slide calipers
Camber-caster-kingpin gauge
Wheel balancer
Pedal effort gauge
Drill
PP
PP–36
PREPARATION – BRAKE
LUBRICANT
PP
Item
Capacity
Classification
Brake fluid
-
SAE J1703 or FMVSS No. 116 DOT3
PP–34
PREPARATION – PARKING BRAKE
PARKING BRAKE
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09042-00010
PP
Torx Socket T30
•
•
No. 1 Parking Brake Cable Assembly
Parking Brake Control Pedal
Assembly
PREPARATION – PARKING BRAKE
PP–35
EQUIPMENT
Torque wrench
PP
PREPARATION – STEERING COLUMN
PP–35
STEERING COLUMN
PREPARATION
SST
09616-00011
Steering Worm Bearing Adjusting
Socket
09950-50013
Puller C Set
(09951-05010)
Hanger 150
(09952-05010)
Slide Arm
(09953-05020)
Center Bolt 150
(09954-05021)
Claw No.2
PP
PP–36
PREPARATION – STEERING COLUMN
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
PP
09025-00010
Torque Wrench (30 kgf-cm)
09042-00010
Torx Socket T30
PREPARATION – STEERING COLUMN
PP–37
EQUIPMENT
Torque wrench
PP
PP–36
PREPARATION – POWER STEERING
POWER STEERING
PREPARATION
SST
PP
09521-24010
Rear Axle Shaft Puller
09612-00012
Rack & Pinion Steering Rack
Housing Stand
09616-00011
Steering Worm Bearing Adjusting
Socket
09922-10010
Variable Open Wrench
PREPARATION – POWER STEERING
PP–37
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09025-00010
Torque Wrench (30 kgf-cm)
09040-00011
Hexagon Wrench Set
PP
(09043-20060)
Socket Hexagon Wrench 6
PP–38
EQUIPMENT
Torque wrench
PP
PREPARATION – POWER STEERING
PP–37
PREPARATION – AIR CONDITIONING
AIR CONDITIONING
PREPARATION
SST
07110-58060
Air Conditioner Service Tool Set
-
(07117-58060)
Refrigerant Drain Service Valve
-
(07117-58070)
T-Joint
-
(07117-58080)
Quick Disconnect Adapter
-
(07117-58090)
Quick Disconnect Adapter
-
(07117-78050)
Refrigerant Charging Gauge
-
(07117-88060)
Refrigerant Charging Hose
-
(07117-88070)
Refrigerant Charging Hose
-
(07117-88080)
Refrigerant Charging Hose
-
09870-00015
A/C Quick Joint Puller No.1
-
09870-00025
A/C Quick Joint Puller No.2
-
PP
PP–38
PREPARATION – AIR CONDITIONING
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09042-00010
Torx Socket T30
-
(09043-20060)
Socket Hexagon Wrench 6
-
(09060-20010)
Socket Wrench
-
Halogen Leak Detector
DENSO Part No.
-
PP
95146-00180
PREPARATION – AIR CONDITIONING
PP–39
EQUIPMENT
Voltmeter
-
Ammeter
-
Ohmmeter
-
Vinyl tape
-
Hexagon wrench (4 mm)
-
Radiator cap tester
-
Torque wrench
-
PP
PP–40
PREPARATION – AIR CONDITIONING
LUBRICANT
PP
Item
Capacity
Classification
Compressor oil
-
ND-OIL 11 or equivalent
PREPARATION – SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
PP–39
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
PREPARATION
SST
09082-00700
SRS Airbag Deployment Tool
-
09082-00750
Airbag Deployment Wire
Sub-harness No.3
-
09082-00780
Airbag Deployment Wire
Sub-harness No.6
-
09082-00802
Airbag Deployment Wire
Sub-Harness No. 8
-
(09082-10801)
Wire A
-
(09082-20801)
Wire B
-
(09082-30801)
Wire C
-
SRS Check Wire
-
09843-18060
PP
PP–40
PREPARATION – SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09042-00010
Torx Socket T30
-
09082-00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
-
Test Lead Set
-
PP
(09083-00150)
PREPARATION – SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
PP–41
EQUIPMENT
Torque wrench
Bolt
Length: 35.0 mm (1.378 in.)
Diameter: 6.0 mm (0.236 in.)
Pitch: 1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
Airbag disposal
Tire
Width: 185 mm (7.28 in.)
Inner diameter: 360 mm (14.17 in.)
Airbag disposal
Tire with disc wheel
Width: 185 mm (7.28 in.)
Inner diameter: 360 mm (14.17 in.)
Airbag disposal
Plastic bag
Airbag disposal
PP
PP–41
PREPARATION – SEAT BELT
SEAT BELT
PREPARATION
SST
09082-00700
SRS Airbag Deployment Tool
-
09082-00770
Airbag Deployment Wire
Sub-harness No.5
-
PP
PP–42
EQUIPMENT
Torque wrench
PP
PREPARATION – SEAT BELT
PP–42
PREPARATION – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082-00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
-
Test Lead Set
-
PP
(09083-00150)
PP–43
PREPARATION – ENGINE IMMOBILISER
ENGINE IMMOBILISER
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082-00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
-
PP
(09083-00150)
Test Lead Set
-
PP–44
PREPARATION – CRUISE CONTROL
CRUISE CONTROL
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082-00040
PP
(09083-00150)
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
-
Test Lead Set
-
PP–45
PREPARATION – LIGHTING
LIGHTING
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09042-00010
Torx Socket T30
-
09082-00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
-
Test Lead Set
-
(09083-00150)
PP
PP–46
PREPARATION – LIGHTING
EQUIPMENT
Tape
PP
To avoid surface damage
PP–46
PREPARATION – WIPER AND WASHER
WIPER AND WASHER
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
PP
09042-00010
Torx Socket T30
-
09082-00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
-
Test Lead Set
-
TOYOTA 4way nozzle Tools
(DENSO Part No.)
-
(09083-00150)
95060-10010
PREPARATION – WIPER AND WASHER
PP–47
EQUIPMENT
Tape
To avoid surface damage
Wire brush
Torque wrench
PP
PP–47
PREPARATION – DOOR LOCK
DOOR LOCK
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082-00040
(09083-00150)
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
-
Test Lead Set
-
PP
PP–48
PREPARATION – METER
METER
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082-00040
PP
(09083-00150)
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
-
Test Lead Set
-
PREPARATION – METER
PP–49
EQUIPMENT
Tape
To avoid surface damage
PP
PP–49
PREPARATION – AUDIO / VISUAL
AUDIO / VISUAL
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09050-00032
Air Drill
-
(09050-00210)
Chuck Set
-
09050-20010
Air Riveter
-
(09050-02010)
Dust Cap
-
(09050-02020)
Nose Piece No.1
-
09060-60350
Revet Cutter
-
09082-00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
-
Test Lead Set
-
(09083-00150)
PP
PP–50
EQUIPMENT
Torque wrench
PP
PREPARATION – AUDIO / VISUAL
PP–50
PREPARATION – NAVIGATION
NAVIGATION
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082-00040
PP
(09083-00150)
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
-
Test Lead Set
-
PREPARATION – PARK ASSIST / MONITORING
PP–51
PARK ASSIST / MONITORING
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082-00040
(09083-00150)
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
-
Test Lead Set
-
PP
PP–52
PREPARATION – HORN
HORN
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082-00040
PP
(09083-00150)
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
-
Test Lead Set
-
PREPARATION – HORN
PP–53
EQUIPMENT
Torque wrench
PP
PREPARATION – WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS
PP–53
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09070-20010
Moulding Remover
-
PP
PP–54
EQUIPMENT
Knife
Piano wire
Plastic sheet
Sealer gun
Torque wrench
PP
Tape
Wooden block or similar object
PREPARATION – WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS
PREPARATION – WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS
PP–55
SSM
Toyota Genuine Windshield Glass Adhesive or Equivalent
-
PP
PP–54
PREPARATION – MIRROR
MIRROR
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082-00040
PP
(09083-00150)
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
-
Test Lead Set
-
PREPARATION – MIRROR
PP–55
EQUIPMENT
Tape
To avoid surface damage
Torque wrench
PP
PREPARATION – INSTRUMENT PANEL
PP–55
INSTRUMENT PANEL
PREPARATION
EQUIPMENT
Torque wrench
-
Tape
To avoid surface damage
PP
PP–56
PREPARATION – SEAT
SEAT
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
PP
09042-00010
"Torx" Socket T30
-
09200-00010
Engine Adjust Kit
-
HINT:
"Torx" is a registered trademark of Textron Inc.
PREPARATION – SEAT
PP–57
EQUIPMENT
Clip remover
Hog ring
Hog ring pliers
Tacker
Protective tape
Torque wrench
To avoid surface damage
PP
PREPARATION – ENGINE HOOD / DOOR
PP–57
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR
PREPARATION
SST
09812-00010
Door Hinge Set Bolt Wrench
09812-00020
Door Hinge Set Bolt Wrench
PP
PP–58
PREPARATION – ENGINE HOOD / DOOR
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09041-00020
Torx Driver T25
09042-00010
Torx Socket T30
09042-00020
Torx Socket T40
PP
PREPARATION – ENGINE HOOD / DOOR
PP–59
EQUIPMENT
Plastic-faced hammer
Tape
To avoid surface damage
Torque wrench
PP
PP–60
PREPARATION – ENGINE HOOD / DOOR
SSM
Toyota Genuine Adhesive 1324, Three Bond 1324 or Equivalent
PP
PP–58
PREPARATION – EXTERIOR
EXTERIOR
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09070-20010
PP
Moulding Remover
-
PREPARATION – EXTERIOR
PP–59
EQUIPMENT
Cleaner
Clip remover
Double-sided tape
Knife
Protective tape
Torque wrench
To avoid surface damage
PP
PP–59
PREPARATION – INTERIOR
INTERIOR
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09070-20010
Moulding Remover
-
PP
PP–60
PREPARATION – INTERIOR
EQUIPMENT
Clip remover
Double-sided tape
Knife
Needle-nose pliers
Protective tape
PP
To avoid surface damage
PP–60
PREPARATION – MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION
MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082-00040
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
-
Test Lead Set
-
PP
(09083-00150)
PP–61
PREPARATION – CAN COMMUNICATION
CAN COMMUNICATION
PREPARATION
RECOMMENDED TOOLS
09082-00040
(09083-00150)
TOYOTA Electrical Tester
-
Test Lead Set
-
PP
POWER STEERING – POWER STEERING SYSTEM
PS–1
POWER STEERING SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
1.
2.
HANDLING PRECAUTIONS FOR SRS AIRBAG
SYSTEM (SEE PAGE RS-1)
NOTICE:
Some service operations affect the SRS airbag. Be
sure to read the precautionary notice for the SRS
airbag before servicing.
PRECAUTIONS FOR REMOVAL, INSTALLATION AND
REPLACEMENT OF ELECTRONIC MOTOR POWER
STEERING COMPONENTS
(a) Be sure to align the front wheels straight ahead
when removing and installing the steering gear
assembly.
(b) When disconnecting the sliding yoke of the steering
column and the pinion shaft of the steering gear
assembly, be sure to put matchmarks before
starting the operation.
(c) When any component related to the steering system
has been removed and either reinstalled or
replaced, perform the steering center point
adjustment (zero point calibration) (see page RS31).
(d) When disconnecting the connector related to the
electronic motor power steering wheel, turn the
power switch ON (IG) (the engine and the hybrid
system are not stopped), center the steering wheel,
turn the power switch OFF, and then disconnect the
connector.
(e) When reconnecting the connector related to the
electronic motor power steering system, ensure that
the power switch is OFF. Center the steering wheel
and then turn the power switch ON (IG) (the engine
and the hybrid system are not stopped).
NOTICE:
Do not turn the power switch ON (IG) (the engine
and the hybrid system are not stopped) when
the steering wheel is not centered.
(f) If the procedures above are not performed out
properly, the steering center point (zero point) will
deviate, which may lead to a difference in steering
effort between right and left. If there is a difference
in steering effort between right and left, perform the
steering center point adjustment (zero point
calibration) (see page RS-31).
NOTICE:
FOR INITIALIZATION
When disconnecting the cable from the negative
(-) battery terminal, initialize the following
systems after the cable is reconnected.
System Name
See Page
Power Window Control System
IN-32
PS
PS–2
POWER STEERING – POWER STEERING SYSTEM
NOTICE:
FOR HYBRID SYSTEM ACTIVATION
• When the warning light is illuminated or the
battery has been disconnected and
reconnected, pressing the power switch may
not start the system on the first try. If so,
press the power switch again.
• With the power switch's power mode
changed to ON (IG), disconnect the battery. If
the key is not in the key slot during
reconnection, DTC B2799 may be output.
PS
PS–3
POWER STEERING – POWER STEERING SYSTEM
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
• A rack and pinion type steering gear is used on all models.
• The PRIUS uses a vehicle-speed sensing type EPS
(Electric Power Steering) on all models.
Power Steering ECU
Steering Wheel
Power Steering Motor
Steering Column
Steering Gear
ECU
POWER STEERING
TORQUE FLOWCHART
Motor
Steering
Gear
Steering
Column
Steering
Wheel
G100841E03
PS
PS–4
POWER STEERING – POWER STEERING SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
Use the table below to help determine the cause of the
problem. The potential causes of the symptoms are listed in
order of probability in the "Suspected area" column of the
table. Check each symptom by checking the suspected areas
in the order they are listed. Replace parts as necessary.
Steering System
Symptom
Steering is heavy.
Steering effort differs between right and left or is
uneven.
While driving, steering effort does not change in
accordance with vehicle speed or steering wheel does
not return properly.
See page
1. Front tires (improperly inflated, unevenly worn)
TW-3
2. Front wheel alignment (Incorrect)
SP-2
3. Front suspension (Lower ball joint)
SP-24
4. Steering gear
PS-49
5. Torque sensor (built into steering column)
-
6. Steering column
SR-7
7. Power steering motor
SR-7
8. Battery and power source system
-
9. Power steering ECU
SR-16
1. Steering center point (zero point) (not recorded completely)
PS-13
2. Front tires (improperly inflated, unevenly worn)
TW-3
3. Front wheel alignment (Incorrect)
SP-2
4. Front suspension (Lower ball joint)
SP-23
5. Steering gear
PS-49
6. Torque sensor (built into steering column)
-
7. Steering column
SR-7
8. Power steering motor
SR-7
9. Power steering ECU
SR-16
1. Front suspension
SP-2
2. Speed sensor
-
3. Skid control ECU
BC-229
4. Combination meter
-
5. Engine speed detection circuit
-
6. Torque sensor (built into steering column)
-
7. Power steering motor
SR-7
8. Power steering ECU
SR-16
1. Front suspension
SP-2
2. Steering intermediate shaft
-
3. Steering gear
PS-49
Friction sound occurs when turning steering wheel
during low speed driving.
1. Power steering motor
SR-7
2. Steering column
SR-7
High-pitched sound (squeaking) occurs when turning
steering wheel slowly with vehicle stopped.
1. Power steering motor
SR-7
Steering wheel vibrates and noise occurs when turning
steering wheel from lock to lock.
1. Power steering motor
SR-7
2. Steering column
SR-7
Knocking (or clunking) sound occurs when turning
steering wheel back and forth while power steering is
in operation.
PS
Suspected area
POWER STEERING – POWER STEERING SYSTEM
PS–5
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
CHECK STEERING EFFORT (TORQUE)
NOTICE:
Some service operations affect the SRS airbag. Be
sure to read the precautionary notice for the SRS
airbag before servicing.
(a) Stop the vehicle on a level, paved road and align the
wheels straight ahead.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal.
(c) Remove the steering pad (see page RS-267).
(d) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery
terminal.
(e) Using a torque wrench, check if the steering wheel
set nut is properly tightened.
Torque: 50 N*m (510 kgf*cm, 37 ft.*lbf)
(f) Turn the power switch ON (IG) (the engine and the
hybrid system are not operated) so that power
steering is ready to operate.
(g) Turn the steering wheel 90 degrees to the right and
check steering effort (torque) while turning. Check in
the opposite direction using the same procedure.
Steering effort (Reference):
5.5 N*m (56 kgf*cm, 49 in.*lbf)
(h) Align the front wheels straight ahead.
(i) Disconnect the cable from negative (-) battery
terminal.
(j) Install the steering pad assembly (see page RS268).
(k) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery
terminal.
(l) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-38).
(m) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
(n) Inspect the airbag warning light (see page RS-31).
G029440E02
2.
CHECK STEERING WHEEL FREE PLAY
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG) so that power
steering is ready to operate.
(b) Align the wheels straight ahead.
(c) Gently turn the steering wheel right and left with
your finger and check the steering wheel free play.
Maximum free play:
30 mm (1.18 in.)
If the free play is out of specification, replace the
sliding yoke sub-assembly or steering gear
assembly with a new one.
PS
PS–6
POWER STEERING – ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM
ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING
SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
1.
PS
FOR INITIALIZATION
NOTICE:
When disconnecting the cable from the negative (-)
battery terminal, initialize the following systems after
the cable is reconnected.
System Name
See procedure
Power Window Control System
IN-32
2. FOR HYBRID SYSTEM ACTIVATION
NOTICE:
• When the warning light is illuminated or the battery
has been disconnected and reconnected, pressing the
power switch may not start the system on the first try.
If so, press the power switch again.
• With the power switch's power mode changed to ON
(IG), disconnect the battery. If the key is not in the key
slot during reconnection, DTC B2799 may be output.
3. HANDLING PRECAUTIONS
(a) When handling the electronic parts:
(1) Avoid any impact to electronic parts such as
ECUs and relays. Replace the parts with new
ones if dropped or subjected to a severe impact.
(2) Do not expose any electronic parts to high
temperature and humidity.
(3) Do not touch the connector terminals in order to
prevent deformation or malfunctions due to
static electricity.
(4) When the power steering ECU has been
replaced with a new one, perform the torque
sensor zero point calibration (see page PS-13).
(b) When handling the steering column:
(1) Avoid any impact to the steering column,
especially to the motor or torque sensor.
Replace the parts with new ones if dropped or
subjected to a severe impact.
(2) Do not pull on the wire harness when moving the
steering column.
(3) When the steering column has been replaced,
perform the torque sensor zero point calibration
after initializing the torque sensor zero point
calibration signal (see page PS-13).
(c) When disconnecting and reconnecting the
connectors:
(1) When disconnecting a connector related to the
electric power steering system, turn the power
switch ON (IG), center the steering wheel, turn
the power switch OFF, and then disconnect the
connector.
POWER STEERING – ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM
4.
PS–7
(2) When reconnecting a connector related to the
electric power steering system, ensure that the
power switch is OFF. Center the steering wheel
and then turn the power switch ON (IG).
NOTICE:
Do not turn the power switch ON (IG) when
the steering wheel is not centered.
(3) If the above operations are not carried out
properly, the steering center point (zero point)
will deviate, which may lead to a difference in
right and left steering effort. If there is a
difference in right and left steering effort, perform
the torque sensor zero point calibration (see
page PS-13).
PRECAUTIONS FOR CAN COMMUNICATION
(a) CAN communication is used to receive information
from the skid control ECU and to transmit warnings
to the meter and the multi-display. When there are
any problems in the CAN communication lines,
DTCs indicating the communication line
malfunctions are output.
(b) Perform troubleshooting for the communication line
problems when the CAN communication DTCs are
output. Be sure to start troubleshooting on the
electronic power steering system when data
communication is normal.
(c) A temporary fix or repair with bypass wiring, etc. is
impossible because the length and path of each
CAN communication line is specific.
PS
PS–8
POWER STEERING – ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
- TORQUE SENSOR
- POWER STEERING MOTOR
ENGINE ROOM JUNCTION BLOCK
- EPS FUSE
PS
F100806E01
POWER STEERING – ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM
PS–9
MULTI-DISPLAY
POWER STEERING ECU
DLC3
DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
- IG1 RELAY
- ECU-IG FUSE
F100807E01
PS
PS–10
POWER STEERING – ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
12 V
Power Switch
: CAN
: BEAN
Power Steering
Motor
Torque Sensor
: Input signal to power
steering ECU
: Output signal from power
steering ECU
Power Steering
ECU
DLC3
Gateway ECU
Hybrid Vehicle Control ECU
Skid Control ECU
Body ECU
: Destination signal
: ECB system trouble
signal
: Shift information signal
: Vehicle model signal
: Stop light switch signal
: Ready condition signal
: Vehicle speed signal
: Grade package
information signal
: Power use permissible signal
: EPS mass current controlling signal
: Steering angle information signal
Combination Meter
: EPS light ON
signal
PS
)
F100808E04
POWER STEERING – ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM
PS–11
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
DESCRIPTION
(a) The electronic power steering system generates
torque through the operation of the motor and the
reduction gear installed on the column shaft in order
to assist steering effort.
Directions and amount of assisting power are
determined by signals from the torque sensor built
into the steering column assembly and by the power
steering ECU, and controlled in accordance with
vehicle speed. As a result, steering effort is
controlled to be light during low speed driving and
moderately high during high speed driving.
(1) Power steering ECU:
The power steering ECU calculates assisting
power based on a steering torque signal from
the torque sensor and a vehicle speed signal
from the skid control ECU. It generates specified
assisting torque by controlling current to the
motor.
(2) Torque sensor:
The torque sensor detects steering effort
generated when the steering wheel is turned
and converts it to an electrical signal.
(3) Power steering motor:
The power steering motor is activated by the
current from the power steering ECU and
generates torque to assist steering effort.
PS
PS–12
POWER STEERING – ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
• Use these procedures to troubleshoot the Electronic
Power Steering System (EPS).
• *: Use the intelligent tester.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
INSPECT BATTERY VOLTAGE
Standard voltage:
11 to 14 V
If the voltage is below 11 V, recharge or replace the battery
before proceeding.
NEXT
3
CHECK DTC AND FREEZE FRAME DATA*
(a) Record DTCs (see page PS-23) and freeze frame data
(see page PS-23).
NEXT
4
PROBLEM SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION
Result
Result
Proceed to
Symptom does not occur
A
Symptom occurs
B
B
Go to step 6
A
5
SYMPTOM SIMULATION
NEXT
6
PS
CHECK CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM*
(a) Check for DTCs.
Result
Result
Proceed to
CAN system DTC is not output.
A
POWER STEERING – ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM
Result
Proceed to
CAN system DTC is output.
B
PS–13
HINT:
• When any CAN communication system DTCs are
output, perform troubleshooting on the CAN
communication system first (see page CA-8).
• When communication to the power steering ECU is
not established through the intelligent tester, inspect
terminals SIL of the DLC3 and power steering ECU
and inspect the IG circuit of the power steering ECU.
B
PROCEED TO CAN COMMUNICATION
SYSTEM
A
7
CHECK DTC*
(a) Check for a DTCs.
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC is not output.
A
DTC is output.
B
B
Go to step 11
A
8
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NEXT
9
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
NEXT
10
IDENTIFICATION OF PROBLEM
NEXT
11
NEXT
REPAIR OR REPLACE
PS
PS–14
12
NEXT
END
PS
POWER STEERING – ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM
CONFIRMATION TEST
POWER STEERING – ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM
PS–15
CALIBRATION
1.
INITIALIZATION OF TORQUE SENSOR ZERO POINT
CALIBRATION SIGNAL
NOTICE:
Under the following conditions, perform the torque
sensor zero point calibration after initializing the
torque sensor zero point calibration signal in the
ECU:
• The steering column (containing the torque
sensor) has been replaced.
• The power steering ECU has been replaced.
• The steering wheel has been replaced.
• The steering gear assembly has been replaced.
• There is a difference in right and left steering
effort.
(a) Center the steering wheel and align the front wheels
straight ahead.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and then initialize the
torque sensor zero point calibration signal by
following the directions on the tester screen.
NOTICE:
Do not turn the steering wheel while initializing
the zero point calibration signal.
(d) Perform steering zero point calibration after turning
the power switch OFF.
NOTICE:
Zero point calibration cannot be carried out with
the power switch ON (IG) after initialization of
the zero point calibration signal is completed.
PS
PS–16
)
PS
POWER STEERING – ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM
F100818
POWER STEERING – ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM
)
PS–17
F100819
2.
TORQUE SENSOR ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a) Center the steering wheel and align the front wheels
straight ahead.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
PS
PS–18
POWER STEERING – ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and then perform the
zero point calibration by following the directions on
the tester screen.
NOTICE:
• The vehicle is stopped.
• Do not start the engine. (Do not turn the
power switch ON (READY).)
• Do not turn the steering wheel.
• The vehicle is on level ground.
(d) Confirm that no DTCs are output after completing
the operation.
(1) When DTC C1515 is output, refer to the
following procedures (see page PS-32).
(2) When DTC C1516 is output, refer to the
following procedures (see page PS-33).
(3) When DTC C1534 is output, refer to the
following procedures (see page PS-36).
PS
POWER STEERING – ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM
)
PS–19
F100820
PS
PS–20
)
PS
POWER STEERING – ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM
F100821
PS–21
POWER STEERING – ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
Use the table below to help determine the cause of the
problem symptom. The potential causes of the symptoms are
listed in order of probability in the "Suspected area" column of
the table. Check each symptom by checking the suspected
areas in the order they are listed. Replace parts as
necessary.
Electronic power steering system
Symptom
Steering is heavy
Steering effort differs between right and left or is
uneven
While driving, steering effort does not change in
accordance with vehicle speed or steering wheel does
not return properly
Suspected area
See page
1. Front tires (Improperly inflated, unevenly worn)
TW-3
2. Front wheel alignment (Incorrect)
SP-2
3. Front suspension (Lower ball joint)
SP-24
4. Steering gear
PS-52
5. Torque sensor (built into steering column)
PS-32
6. Steering column
SR-11
7. Power steering motor
PS-37
8. Battery and power source system
-
9. Power source voltage of power steering ECU
PS-44
10.Power steering ECU
SR-16
1. Steering center point (zero point) is not recorded completely
PS-13
2. Front tires (Improperly inflated, unevenly worn)
TW-3
3. Front wheel alignment (Incorrect)
SP-2
4. Front suspension (Lower ball joint)
SP-24
5. Steering gear
PS-52
6. Torque sensor (built into steering column)
PS-32
7. Steering column
SR-11
8. Power steering motor
PS-37
9. Power steering ECU
SR-16
1. Front suspension
-
2. Speed sensor
BC-218
3. Skid control ECU
BC-229
4. Engine speed detection circuit
-
5. ECM
ES-469
6. Torque sensor (built into steering column)
PS-32
7. Power steering motor
PS-37
8. Power steering ECU
SR-16
9. CAN communication system
CA-8
1. Front suspension
-
2. Steering intermediate shaft
-
3. Steering gear
PS-52
Friction sound occurs when turning steering wheel
during low speed driving
1. Power steering motor
PS-37
2. Steering column
SR-11
High-pitched sound (squeaking) occurs when turning
steering wheel slowly with vehicle stopped
Power steering motor
PS-37
Steering wheel vibrates and noise occurs when turning
steering wheel with the vehicle stopped
1. Power steering motor
PS-37
2. Steering column
SR-11
1. Power steering ECU
SR-16
2. Wire harness
PS-44
3. CAN communication system
CA-8
4. Multi-display
NS-172
Clunking sound occurs when turning steering wheel
back and forth while power steering is in operation
PS warning is always indicated on multi-display
PS
PS–22
POWER STEERING – ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
CHECK POWER STEERING ECU
P8
P7
P10
P9
F044303E04
(a) Measure the voltage and resistance of the
connectors.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
PIG (P7-1) - PGND (P7-2)
W - W-B
Power source
Always
10 to 16 V
PGND (P7-2) - Body
ground
W-B - Body ground
Power ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
M1 (P9-1) - PGND (P7-2)
R - W-B
Power steering motor
signal
With power switch ON
(IG), turn the steering
wheel to left
Below 1 V
With power switch ON
(IG), turn the steering
wheel to right
10 to 16 V
With power switch ON
(IG), turn the steering
wheel to left
10 to 16 V
With power switch ON
(IG), turn the steering
wheel to right
Below 1 V
M2 (P9-2) - PGND (P7-2)
PS
B - W-B
Power steering motor
signal
CANH (P8-1) - CANL (P87)
B-W
CAN communication line
Power switch is OFF
54 to 69 Ω
SIL (P8-2) - PGND (P7-2)
W - W-B
Diagnosis communication
signal
Communication is
established by connecting
the intelligent tester (with
CAN VIM) to the DLC3
Pulse generation (see
waveform 1)
IG (P8-6) - PGND (P7-2)
B - W-B
IG power source
Power switch is ON (IG)
10 to 16 V
TRQ1 (P10-5) - PGND
(P7-2)
B - W-B
Torque sensor signal
With power switch ON
(IG), turn the steering
wheel to left and right
0.3 to 4.7 V
TRQV (P10-6) - PGND
(P7-2)
Y - W-B
Torque sensor voltage
source
Power switch ON (IG)
7.5 to 8.5 V
TRQ2 (P10-7) - PGND
(P7-2)
R - W-B
Torque sensor signal
With power switch ON
(IG), turn the steering
wheel to left and right
0.3 to 4.7 V
TRQG (P10-8) - PGND
(P7-2)
W - W-B
Torque sensor ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
POWER STEERING – ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM
PS–23
(b) Using an oscilloscope, check waveform 1.
Waveform 1 (Reference)
Waveform 1
Terminal
SIL - Body ground
Tool setting
5 V/DIV, 1 ms/DIV
Condition
Communication is established by
connecting the intelligent tester (with
CAN VIM) to the DLC3
HINT:
If the result is not as specified, the ECU may have a
malfunction.
C081996E05
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
1.
CG
SG
CANH
SIL
CHECK DLC3
The vehicle's ECU uses the ISO 15765-4 communication
protocol. The terminal arrangement of the DLC3
complies with ISO 15031-03 and matches the ISO
15765-4 format.
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
CANL
BAT
B126621E01
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
SIL (7) - SG (5)
Bus "+" line
During transmission
Pulse generation
CG (4) - Body ground Chassis
ground
Chassis ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
SG (5) - Body ground Signal
ground
Signal ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
BAT (16) - Body ground
Battery positive
Always
11 to 14 V
CANH (6) - CANL (14)
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Power switch is OFF*
54 to 69 Ω
CANH (6) - Battery positive
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Power switch is OFF*
1 MΩ or higher
CANH (6) - CG (4)
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Power switch is OFF*
1 kΩ or higher
CANL (14) - Battery position
LOW-level CAN bus line
Power switch is OFF*
1 MΩ or higher
CANL (14) - CG (4)
LOW-level CAN bus line
Power switch is OFF*
1 kΩ or higher
NOTICE:
*: Before measuring the resistance, leave the vehicle
as is for at least 1 minute and do not operate the
ignition switch, other switches or the doors.
If the result is not as specified, the DLC3 may have a
malfunction. Repair or replace the harness and
connector.
PS
PS–24
POWER STEERING – ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM
Intelligent Tester
DLC3
CAN VIM
2.
B126098E01
DTC CHECK / CLEAR
Intelligent Tester
1.
2.
DLC3
CAN VIM
B126098E01
PS
HINT:
Connect the cable of the intelligent tester (with CAN
VIM) to the DLC3, turn the power switch ON (IG) and
attempt to use the tester. If the display indicates that a
communication error has occurred, there is a problem
either with the vehicle or with the tester.
• If communication is normal when the tester is
connected to another vehicle, inspect the DLC3 on
the original vehicle.
• If communication is still not possible when the tester
is connected to another vehicle, the problem may be
in the tester itself. Consult the Service Department
listed in the tester's instruction
WARNING LIGHT
(a) When a problem occurs in the electric power
steering system, the PS warning is indicated on the
multi-display and the master warning light on the
combination meter comes on to inform the driver of
the problem.
CHECK DTC
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Read the DTCs by following the display on the
intelligent tester.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual for
further details.
CLEAR DTC
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Clear the DTCs by following the display on the
intelligent tester.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual for
further details.
POWER STEERING – ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM
PS–25
FREEZE FRAME DATA
NOTICE:
• It is difficult to show the specified values (judgment
values) clearly because freeze frame data values
significantly change due to differences in
measurement conditions, surroundings or vehicle
conditions. Because of this reason, there may be a
problem even when the values are within
specifications.
• Turn the power switch ON (IG) and park the vehicle on
level ground to check the freeze frame data using the
intelligent tester.
1. Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the DLC3.
2. Turn the power switch ON (IG) and check the freeze frame
data by following the prompts on the display of the
intelligent tester.
Power steering ECU
Item
Item Description / Range
(Display)
Inspection Condition
Reference Value
TRQ1
Torque sensor 1 output value /
min.: 0 V, max.: 5 V
Steering wheel is not turned
(without load)
2.3 to 2.7 V
Turning steering wheel to right
with vehicle stopped
2.5 to 4.7 V
Turning steering wheel to left with
vehicle stopped
0.3 to 2.5 V
Steering wheel is not turned
(without load)
2.3 to 2.7 V
Turning steering wheel to right
with vehicle stopped
2.5 to 4.7 V
Turning steering wheel to left with
vehicle stopped
0.3 to 2.5 V
Steering wheel is not turned
(without load)
2.3 to 2.7 V
Turning steering wheel to right
with vehicle stopped
2.5 to 4.7 V
Turning steering wheel to left with
vehicle stopped
0.3 to 2.5 V
Vehicle speed from meter / min.:
0 km/h, max.: 255 km/h
Vehicle is stopped
0 km/h
Vehicle is driven at a constant
speed
No significant fluctuation
MOTOR ACTUAL
Amount of current to motor / min.:
-128 A, max.: 127 A
-
-
COMMAND VALUE
Demanded amount of current to
motor / min.: -128 A, max.: 127 A
-
-
THERMISTOR TEMP
ECU substrate temperature /
min.: -50°C, max.: 205°C
Power switch is ON (IG)
-
PIG SUPPLY
Power source voltage to activate
motor / min.: 0 V, max.: 25.5 V
Power steering is in operation
10 to 16 V
IG SUPPLY
ECU power source voltage / min.:
0 V, max.: 25.5 V
-
10 to 16 V
TRQ1 ZERO VAL
Zero point value of torque sensor
1 / min.: 0 V, max.: 5 V
Steering wheel is not turned
(without load)
2.3 to 2.7 V
TRQ2 ZERO VAL
Zero point value of torque sensor
2 / min.: 0 V, max.: 5 V
Steering wheel is not turned
(without load)
2.3 to 2.7 V
TRQ3 ZERO VAL
Zero point value of torque sensor
for assist control / min.: 0 V, max.:
5V
Steering wheel is not turned
(without load)
2.3 to 2.7 V
TRQ2
TRQ3
SPD
Torque sensor 2 output value /
min.: 0 V, max.: 5 V
Torque value for assist control /
min.: 0 V, max.: 5 V
PS
PS–26
Item
Item Description / Range
(Display)
Inspection Condition
MTR TERMINAL (+)
Motor terminal M1 voltage / min.:
0 V, max.: 25.5 V
Turning steering wheel to right
10 to 16 V
Turning steering wheel to left
Below 1 V
Motor terminal M2 voltage / min.:
0 V, max.: 25.5 V
Turning steering wheel to right
Below 1 V
Turning steering wheel to left
10 to 16 V
# CODES
Number of detected DTCs when
freeze frame data is stored / min.:
0 times, max.: 255 times
-
-
READY STATUS
HV system "READY" / OFF/ON
HV system "READY"
ON
HV system not "READY"
OFF
MTR TERMINAL (-)
PS
POWER STEERING – ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM
Reference Value
POWER STEERING – ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM
PS–27
FAIL-SAFE CHART
When a problem occurs in the electronic motor power
steering system, the P/S warning is indicated on the multidisplay, the master warning light on the combination meter
comes on, and steering power assist is stopped, fixed at a
particular point, or decreased simultaneously to protect the
system.
Electronic power steering system
DTC No.
Malfunction
Fail-safe
C1511
C1512
C1513
C1514
C1517
Torque sensor malfunction
Power assist stops.
C1524
Motor malfunction
Power assist stops.
C1531
C1532
Power steering ECU malfunction
Power assist stops.
C1533
Temperature sensor malfunction in power
steering ECU
Amount of power assist is limited.
C1551
IG power source voltage error
Power assist stops.
C1552
PIG power source voltage error
Power assist stops.
C1554
Power source relay malfunction
Power assist stops.
C1555
Motor relay malfunction
Power assist stops.
U0073
CAN bus malfunction
Amount of power assist is fixed for a speed of
43 mph (70 km/h).
U0121
Skid control ECU communication error
Amount of power assist is fixed for a speed of
43 mph (70 km/h).
-
Extremely high temperature in ECU
Amount of power assist is limited until ECU
temperature goes down.
-
Power source voltage drop
Power assist is interrupted, but normal power
assist is resumed when voltage returns.
HINT:
Amount of power assist may be decreased to prevent the
motor and ECUs from overheating if the steering wheel is
continuously turned when the vehicle is either stopped or
driven at a low speed, or if the steering wheel is kept at either
full lock position for a long time. In that case, the amount of
power assist returns to normal if the steering wheel is not
turned for approximately 10 minutes with the engine idling.
PS
PS–28
POWER STEERING – ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM
DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST
1.
READ DATA LIST
HINT:
Using the intelligent tester's DATA LIST allows switch,
sensor, actuator and other item values to be read without
removing any parts. Reading the DATA LIST early in
troubleshooting is one way to save time.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and press the
intelligent tester main switch on.
(c) Read the DATA LIST by following the directions on
the tester screen.
Power steering ECU
Item
Item Description / Range
(Display)
Inspection Condition
Reference Value
TRQ1
Torque sensor 1 output value /
min.: 0 V, max.: 5 V
Steering wheel is not turned
(without load)
2.3 to 2.7 V
Turning steering wheel to right
with vehicle stopped
2.5 to 4.7 V
Turning steering wheel to left with
vehicle stopped
0.3 to 2.5 V
Steering wheel is not turned
(without load)
2.3 to 2.7 V
Turning steering wheel to right
with vehicle stopped
2.5 to 4.7 V
Turning steering wheel to left with
vehicle stopped
0.3 to 2.5 V
Steering wheel is not turned
(without load)
2.3 to 2.7 V
Turning steering wheel to right
with vehicle stopped
2.5 to 4.7 V
Turning steering wheel to left with
vehicle stopped
0.3 to 2.5 V
Vehicle speed from meter / min.:
0 km/h, max.: 255 km/h
Vehicle is stopped
0 km/h
Vehicle is driven at a constant
speed
No significant fluctuation
MOTOR ACTUAL
Amount of current to motor / min.:
-128 A, max.: 127 A
-
-
COMMAND VALUE
Demanded amount of current to
motor / min.: -128 A, max.: 127 A
-
-
THERMISTOR TEMP
ECU substrate temperature /
min.: -50°C, max.: 205°C
Power switch is ON (IG)
-
PIG SUPPLY
Power source voltage to activate
motor / min.: 0 V, max.: 25.5 V
Power steering is in operation
10 to 16 V
IG SUPPLY
ECU power source voltage / min.:
0 V, max.: 25.5 V
-
10 to 16 V
TRQ1 ZERO VAL
Zero point value of torque sensor
1 / min.: 0 V, max.: 5 V
Steering wheel is not turned
(without load)
2.3 to 2.7 V
TRQ2 ZERO VAL
Zero point value of torque sensor
2 / min.: 0 V, max.: 5 V
Steering wheel is not turned
(without load)
2.3 to 2.7 V
TRQ3 ZERO VAL
Zero point value of torque sensor
for assist control / min.: 0 V, max.:
5V
Steering wheel is not turned
(without load)
2.3 to 2.7 V
MTR TERMINAL (+)
Motor terminal M1 voltage / min.:
0 V, max.: 25.5 V
Turning steering wheel to right
10 to 16 V
Turning steering wheel to left
Below 1 V
TRQ2
TRQ3
SPD
PS
Torque sensor 2 output value /
min.: 0 V, max.: 5 V
Torque value for assist control /
min.: 0 V, max.: 5 V
POWER STEERING – ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM
Item
Item Description / Range
(Display)
Inspection Condition
Reference Value
MTR TERMINAL (-)
Motor terminal M2 voltage / min.:
0 V, max.: 25.5 V
Turning steering wheel to right
Below 1 V
Turning steering wheel to left
10 to 16 V
MTR OVERHEAT
Continuous overheat prevention
control record / REC/UNREC
-
-
MTR LOW POWER
PIG power source voltage drop
record / REC/UNREC
-
-
CONTROL MODE
Codes indicating DTC detection
timing during ECU control are
displayed in hexadecimal
-
-
IG ON/OFF TIMES
Number of times power switch is
turned on (IG) after DTC
detection / min.: 0 times, max.:
255 times
-
-
# CODES
Number of detected DTCs when
freeze frame data is stored / min.:
0 max.: 255
-
-
ASSIST MAP
Selected assist map
-
-
ECU I.D.
ECU identification information
-
-
TEST MODE STAT
Selected mode / NORMAL
MODE/TEST MODE
-
-
READY STATUS
HV system "READY" / OFF/ON
HV system "READY"
ON
HV system not "READY"
OFF
PS–29
PS
PS–30
POWER STEERING – ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
HINT:
If a trouble code is displayed during the DTC check, inspect
the circuit listed for that code. For details of each code, refer
to the "See page" for the respective "DTC No." in the DTC
chart.
Electronic power steering system
PS
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
See page
C1511
Torque Sensor Circuit Malfunction
- Steering column (torque sensor)
- Power steering ECU
PS-29
C1512
Torque Sensor Circuit Malfunction
- Steering column (torque sensor)
- Power steering ECU
PS-29
C1513
Torque Sensor Circuit Malfunction
- Steering column (torque sensor)
- Power steering ECU
PS-29
C1514
Torque Sensor Power Supply
Abnormal
- Steering column (torque sensor)
- Power steering ECU
PS-29
C1515
Torque Sensor Zero Point
Adjustment Undone
- Torque sensor zero point
calibration
- Steering column
PS-32
C1516
Torque Sensor Zero Point
Adjustment Incomplete
- Torque sensor zero point
calibration failure
- Steering column
PS-33
C1517
Torque Hold Abnormal
- Steering column (torque sensor)
- Power steering ECU
PS-29
C1524
Motor Circuit Malfunction
- Steering column (power steering
motor)
- Power steering ECU
PS-34
C1531
ECU Malfunction
- Power steering ECU
PS-36
C1532
ECU Malfunction
- Power steering ECU
PS-36
C1533
ECU Malfunction
- Power steering ECU
PS-36
C1534
ECU Malfunction
- Power steering ECU
PS-36
C1551
IG Power Supply Voltage
Malfunction
- ECU-IG fuse
- IG power source circuit
- Power steering ECU
PS-37
C1552
PIG Power Supply Voltage
Malfunction
- EPS fuse
- PIG power source circuit
- Power steering ECU
PS-39
C1554
Power Supply Relay Failure
- EPS fuse
- PIG power source circuit
- Power steering ECU
PS-39
C1555
Motor Relay Welding Failure
- EPS fuse
- PIG power source circuit
- Power steering ECU
PS-39
C1581
Assist Map Number Un-Writing
- Power steering ECU
PS-41
U0073
Control Module Communication
Bus OFF
- CAN communication system
PS-42
U0121
Lost Communication with Antilock Brake System (ABS) Control
Module
- CAN communication system
- Skid control ECU
PS-42
POWER STEERING – ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM
DTC
C1511
Torque Sensor Circuit Malfunction
DTC
C1512
Torque Sensor Circuit Malfunction
DTC
C1513
Torque Sensor Circuit Malfunction
DTC
C1514
Torque Sensor Power Supply Abnormal
DTC
C1517
Torque Hold Abnormal
PS–31
DESCRIPTION
The torque sensor converts rotation torque input to the steering wheel into an electrical signal and sends
it to the ECU. Based on this signal, the ECU detects steering effort.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C1511
Torque sensor (TRQ1) signal error or stop
•
•
Torque sensor (built into steering column)
Power steering ECU
C1512
Torque sensor (TRQ2) signal error or stop
•
•
Torque sensor (built into steering column)
Power steering ECU
C1513
Deviation between torque sensors (TRQ1 and
TRQ2) is out of specification
•
•
Torque sensor (built into steering column)
Power steering ECU
C1514
Torque sensor power source voltage error
•
•
Torque sensor (built into steering column)
Power steering ECU
C1517
Temporary control due to malfunction related
to torque sensor continues for a long time
•
•
Torque sensor (built into steering column)
Power steering ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
Torque Sensor
Power Steering ECU
TRQV
TRQ1
TRQ2
TRQG
)
F100805E02
PS
PS–32
POWER STEERING – ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (TORQUE SENSOR)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and turn the intelligent
tester main switch on.
(c) Select the items "TRQ1" and "TRQ2" in the DATA LIST.
Power Steering ECU
Item
Item Description / Range
(Display)
Inspection Condition
Reference Value
TRQ1
Torque sensor 1 output value /
min.: 0 V, max.: 5 V
Steering wheel is not turned
(without load)
2.3 to 2.7 V
Turning steering wheel to right
with vehicle stopped
2.5 to 4.7 V
Turning steering wheel to left with
vehicle stopped
0.3 to 2.5 V
Steering wheel is not turned
(without load)
2.3 to 2.7 V
Turning steering wheel to right
with vehicle stopped
2.5 to 4.7 V
Turning steering wheel to left with
vehicle stopped
0.3 to 2.5 V
TRQ2
Torque sensor 2 output value /
min.: 0 V, max.: 5 V
(d) Read the values of "TRQ1" and "TRQ2" on the tester
display when the steering wheel is centered (without
load).
Standard voltage:
2.3 to 2.7 V
(e) Check the difference in the values of "TRQ1" and
"TRQ2" when the steering wheel is centered (without
load).
Standard voltage:
0.3 V or less
(f) Read the value of the torque sensor on the tester display
when the steering wheel is turned.
(1) Turn the steering wheel from its center position to
the right full lock position and read the values of
"TRQ1" and "TRQ2" on the tester display.
Standard voltage:
2.5 to 4.7 V
(2) Turn the steering wheel from its center position to
the left full lock position and read the values of
"TRQ1" and "TRQ2" on the tester display.
Standard voltage:
0.3 to 2.5 V
(3) Check the difference in the values of "TRQ1" and
"TRQ2".
Standard voltage:
0.3 V or less
PS
OK
NG
REPLACE POWER STEERING ECU
PS–33
POWER STEERING – ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM
2
CHECK STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY (TORQUE SENSOR)
(a) Measure the voltage of the ECU.
Standard voltage
P10
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
P10-6 (TRQV) - P10-8
(TRQG)
Power switch is ON (IG)
7.5 to 8.5 V
OK
REPLACE POWER STEERING ECU
6 (TRQV)
8 (TRQG)
)
F100822E04
NG
3
CHECK POWER STEERING ECU
(a) Measure the voltage of the ECU.
Standard voltage
P10
5 (TRQ1)
7 (TRQ2)
8 (TRQG)
)
F100822E05
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
P10-5 (TRQ1) - P10-8
(TRQG)
Power switch is ON (IG)
Steering wheel center
position
2.3 to 2.7
P10-7 (TRQ2) - P10-8
(TRQG)
Power switch is ON (IG)
Steering wheel center
position
2.3 to 2.7
P10-5 (TRQ1) - P10-8
(TRQG)
Power switch is ON (IG)
Steering wheel turned
to right
2.5 to 4.7
P10-7 (TRQ2) - P10-8
(TRQG)
Power switch is ON (IG)
Steering wheel turned
to right
2.5 to 4.7
P10-5 (TRQ1) - P10-8
(TRQG)
Power switch is ON (IG)
Steering wheel turned
to left
0.3 to 2.5 V
P10-7 (TRQ2) - P10-8
(TRQG)
Power switch is ON (IG)
Steering wheel turned
to left
0.3 to 2.5 V
OK
REPLACE STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
NG
REPLACE POWER STEERING ECU
PS
PS–34
POWER STEERING – ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM
DTC
C1515
Torque Sensor Zero Point Adjustment Undone
DESCRIPTION
This DTC does not indicate a malfunction. The power steering ECU outputs this DTC when it determines
that the torque sensor zero point calibration has not been performed.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C1515
This DTC is detected when torque sensor
zero point calibration has not been performed.
•
•
Torque sensor zero point calibration
(There is no malfunction if this DTC is not
output again after performing zero point
calibration.)
Steering column
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CLEAR DTC
(a) Clear the DTC (see page PS-23).
NEXT
2
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION OF TORQUE SENSOR
(a) Perform the torque sensor zero point calibration (see
page PS-13).
NEXT
3
RECONFIRM DTC
(a) Check for DTCs (see page PS-23).
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTCs are still output even after
performing torque sensor zero point
calibration 3 times.
A
DTCs are still output even after
performing torque sensor zero point
calibration once or twice.
B
Normal system code is output.
C
HINT:
Replace the steering column assembly if DTCs are still
output even after performing the torque sensor zero
point calibration 3 times.
B
C
PS
A
REPLACE STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
Go to step 2
END
POWER STEERING – ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM
DTC
C1516
PS–35
Torque Sensor Zero Point Adjustment Incomplete
DESCRIPTION
This DTC does not indicate a malfunction. The power steering ECU outputs this DTC when it determines
that the torque sensor zero point calibration has not been completed normally.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Procedure
C1516
Torque sensor zero point calibration has not
been completed normally due to touching the
steering wheel during calibration.
There is no malfunction if this DTC is not
output again after clearing the DTCs,
initializing the zero point calibration signal,
and performing zero point calibration.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CLEAR DTC
(a) Clear the DTC (see page PS-23).
NEXT
2
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION OF TORQUE SENSOR
(a) Perform the torque sensor zero point calibration (see
page PS-13).
NEXT
3
RECONFIRM DTC
(a) Check for DTCs.
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTCs are still output even after
performing torque sensor zero point
calibration 3 times.
A
DTCs are still output even after
performing torque sensor zero point
calibration once or twice.
B
Normal system code is output.
C
HINT:
Replace the steering column assembly if DTCs are still
output even after performing the torque sensor zero
point calibration 3 times.
B
C
A
REPLACE STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
Go to step 2
END
PS
PS–36
POWER STEERING – ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM
DTC
C1524
Motor Circuit Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The power steering ECU supplies current to the power steering motor through this circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C1524
Voltage error between motor terminals
•
•
Steering column (power steering motor)
Power steering ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
Power Steering Motor
Power Steering ECU
M1
M2
)
F100804E04
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK POWER STEERING ECU
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Measure the voltage of the ECU.
Standard voltage
P7
PS
7 (PGND)
1 (M1)
P9
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
P9-1 (M1) - P7-2 (PGND)
The steering wheel is
turned to the left.
Below 1 V
P9-1 (M1) - P7-2 (PGND)
The steering wheel is
turned to the right.
10 to 16 V
P9-2 (M2) - P7-2 (PGND)
The steering wheel is
turned to the left.
10 to 16 V
P9-2 (M2) - P7-2 (PGND)
The steering wheel is
turned to the right.
Below 1 V
2 (M2)
NG
)
F100822E06
REPLACE POWER STEERING ECU
POWER STEERING – ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM
PS–37
OK
2
CHECK POWER STEERING MOTOR
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the P9 power steering ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
P9
M1
M2
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
P9-1 (M1) - P9-2 (M2)
0.04 to 0.1 Ω
P9-1 (M1) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
P9-2 (M2) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
F046435E06
NG
REPLACE STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
OK
REPLACE POWER STEERING ECU
PS
PS–38
POWER STEERING – ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM
DTC
C1531
ECU Malfunction
DTC
C1532
ECU Malfunction
DTC
C1533
ECU Malfunction
DTC
C1534
ECU Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
Fail-safe function operates to stop power assist while DTCs indicating ECU malfunctions are output.
However, power assist continues when DTC C1534 is output because it indicates an EEPROM error in
the ECU.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C1531
ECU internal malfunction (CPU malfunction)
is detected.
Power steering ECU
C1532
ECU internal malfunction (Peripheral circuit
malfunction) is detected.
Power steering ECU
C1533
ECU internal malfunction (Substrate temp.
sensor malfunction) is detected.
Power steering ECU
C1534
ECU internal malfunction (EEPROM error) is
detected.
Power steering ECU
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
RECONFIRM DTC
(a) Check for DTCs.
OK:
DTCs other than C1531, C1532, C1533 and C1534
are not output.
NG
OK
REPLACE POWER STEERING ECU
PS
REPAIR CIRCUIT INDICATED BY OUTPUT
CODE
POWER STEERING – ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM
DTC
C1551
PS–39
IG Power Supply Voltage Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The power steering ECU distinguishes on / off status of the power switch through this circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C1551
There is an open or short in the IG power
source circuit with the power switch ON (IG).
•
•
•
ECU-IG fuse
IG power source circuit
Power steering ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
Power Steering ECU
IG1
ECU-IG
IG
Power Source Control ECU
IGID
PGND
DC/DC
MAIN
)
F100803E04
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT FUSE (ECU-IG)
(a) Remove the ECU-IG fuse from the driver side junction
block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the fuse.
PS
PS–40
POWER STEERING – ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
INSPECT FOR SHORT IN ALL
COMPONENTS CONNECTED TO FUSE AND
REPAIR OR REPLACE THEM IF NEEDED,
AND REPLACE FUSE
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (POWER STEERING ECU - BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the P8 power steering ECU connector.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
6 (IG)
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
P8-6 (IG) - Body ground
Power switch is ON (IG)
10 to 16 V
P8
NG
F046437E04
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (POWER STEERING ECU - BODY GROUND)
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the P7 power steering ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire
Harness
Side
P7
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
P7-2 (PGND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
7 (PGND)
F046438E11
OK
REPLACE POWER STEERING ECU
PS
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
POWER STEERING – ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM
DTC
C1552
PIG Power Supply Voltage Malfunction
DTC
C1554
Power Supply Relay Failure
DTC
C1555
Motor Relay Welding Failure
PS–41
DESCRIPTION
When a problem occurs in the system, the power source relay (built into the power steering ECU) circuit
and the motor relay (built into the power steering ECU) circuit are shut off to stop power assist. It is
necessary to replace the ECU when there is a problem in the relay because each relay is built into the
ECU.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C1552
PIG power source voltage error
•
•
•
EPS H-fuse
PIG power source circuit
Power steering ECU
C1554
Power source relay malfunction
•
•
•
EPS H-fuse
PIG power source circuit
Power steering ECU
C1555
Motor relay malfunction
•
•
•
EPS Fuse
PIG power source circuit
Power steering ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
Power Steering ECU
DC/DC
EPS
PIG
MAIN
)
PGND
F100802E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
PS
1
INSPECT FUSE (EPS)
(a) Remove the EPS H-fuse from the engine room junction
block.
PS–42
POWER STEERING – ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM
(b) Measure the resistance of the fuse.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
INSPECT FOR SHORT IN ALL
COMPONENTS CONNECTED TO FUSE AND
REPAIR OR REPLACE THEM IF NEEDED,
AND REPLACE FUSE
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (POWER STEERING ECU - BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the P7 power steering ECU connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire
Harness
Side
P7
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
P7-1 (PIG) - Body ground
10 to 16 V
NG
1 (PIG)
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
F046438E12
OK
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (POWER STEERING ECU - BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the P7 power steering ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire
harness
Side
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
P7-2 (PGND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
P7
NG
2 (PGND)
F046438E06
OK
REPLACE POWER STEERING ECU
PS
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
POWER STEERING – ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM
DTC
C1581
PS–43
Assist Map Number Un-Writing
DESCRIPTION
The power steering ECU outputs this DTC when it determines that assist map is not written in the ECU. It
is necessary to replace the power steering ECU when this code is output because this malfunction cannot
be repaired.
HINT:
The assist map is data written in the power steering ECU to control assisting power. The assist map is
selected from four types based on the vehicle specification communication data (designation and grade
package information).
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C1581
Assist map is not written in the power steering
ECU.
Power steering ECU
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
RECONFIRM DTC
(a) Check for DTCs.
OK:
DTCs other than C1581 are not output.
NG
REPAIR CIRCUIT INDICATED BY OUTPUT
CODE
OK
REPLACE POWER STEERING ECU
PS
PS–44
POWER STEERING – ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM
DTC
U0073
Control Module Communication Bus OFF
DTC
U0121
Lost Communication with Anti-lock Brake System (ABS) Control Module
DESCRIPTION
The power steering ECU receives signals from the skid control ECU (ECB ECU) via CAN communication.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
U0073
CAN communication error (CAN bus is off)
CAN communication system
U0121
Skid control ECU communication error
•
•
CAN communication system
Skid control ECU (when only U0121 is
output)
HINT:
When 2 or more DTCs starting with [U] are output simultaneously, inspect the connectors and wire
harness of each ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Junction Connector
Power Steering ECU
CANH
CANL
Skid Control ECU
CANH
CANL
)
PS
F100827E03
POWER STEERING – ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM
PS–45
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DTC
(a) Using the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM), check for
DTCs.
OK:
DTC is not output.
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NG
GO TO CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM TROUBLESHOOTING
PS
PS–46
POWER STEERING – ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM
PS Warning is Always Shown on Multi-Display
DESCRIPTION
The troubleshooting procedure for a situation when no DTCs are output but a PS warning is always
indicated is specified here. The PS warning remains on when there is an open in the IG circuit that inputs
power source voltage to the power steering ECU.
PS
POWER STEERING – ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM
PS–47
WIRING DIAGRAM
Gateway ECU
Power Steering ECU
CA1L
CANL
CA1H
CANH
Multi-display
GTX-
TX1-
GTX+
TX1+
IG
ECU-IG
PGND
IG1
from Power Source Control ECU
DC/DC
MAIN
)
F100925E01
PS
PS–48
POWER STEERING – ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CONNECTOR CONNECTION CONDITION
(a) Check the indication condition of the PS warning while
wiggling the power steering ECU connector and wire
harness up and down, and right and left.
OK:
Warning indication does not change.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
2
INSPECT CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
(a) Using the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM), check for
DTCs and confirm that there are no problems in the CAN
communication system.
OK:
DTCs are not output.
NG
GO TO CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
OK
3
INSPECT MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM (BEAN)
(a) Using the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM), check for
DTCs and confirm that there are no problems in the
multiplex communication system (BEAN).
OK:
DTCs are not output.
NG
GO TO MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION
SYSTEM
OK
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (POWER STEERING ECU - BATTERY)
(a) Disconnect the P7 and P8 power steering ECU
connectors.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard voltage
Wire
Harness
Side
PS
P7
2 (PGND)
P8
6 (IG)
F046436E03
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
P8-6 (IG) - P7-2 (PGND)
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 16 V
POWER STEERING – ELECTRONIC POWER STEERING SYSTEM
NG
PS–49
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
5
REPLACE POWER STEERING ECU
NEXT
6
CHECK PS WARNING ON MULTI-DISPLAY
(a) Check for the PS warning indication on the multi-display.
OK:
PS warning is not indicated.
OK
END
NG
REPLACE MULTI-DISPLAY
PS
PS–48
POWER STEERING – STEERING GEAR
STEERING GEAR
POWER STEERING
STEERING
COMPONENTS
FRONT NO. 1 STABILIZER
BRACKET RH
19 (194, 14)
FRONT STABILIZER
LINK ASSEMBLY RH
19 (194, 14)
FRONT NO. 1 STABILIZER
BRACKET LH
FRONT NO. 1
STABILIZER BAR
FRONT STABILIZER
LINK ASSEMBLY LH
74 (755, 55)
74 (755, 55)
FRONT STABILIZER BAR
74 (755, 55)
74 (755, 55)
PS
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
G100840E03
PS–49
POWER STEERING – STEERING GEAR
COLUMN HOLE COVER
SILENCER SHEET
STEERING SLIDING YOKE SUB-ASSEMBLY
STEERING INTERMEDIATE SHAFT
CLIP
35 (360, 26)
NO. 1 STEERING COLUMN
HOLE COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
CLIP
83 (846, 61)
*60 (612, 44)
58 (591, 43)
STEERING RACK END
SUB-ASSEMBLY
49 (500, 36)
NO. 1 TIE ROD END
SUB-ASSEMBLY
NO. 2 STEERING RACK
BOOT CLAMP
STEERING RACK BOOT CLIP
NO. 2 STEERING RACK
BOOT
74 (749, 54)
NO. 1 STEERING RACK
BOOT
*For use with SST
Non-reusable part
CLIP
83 (846, 61)
*60 (612, 44)
49 (500, 36)
STEERING RACK END SUB-ASSEMBLY
NO. 1 STEERING RACK BOOT CLAMP
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
STEERING RACK BOOT CLIP
Molybdenum disulfide lithium base grease
Silicon grease
74 (749, 54)
NO. 2 TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY
G100839E04
PS
PS–50
POWER STEERING – STEERING GEAR
REMOVAL
1.
PLACE FRONT WHEELS FACING STRAIGHT AHEAD
2.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
3.
REMOVE COLUMN HOLE COVER SILENCER SHEET
(See page SR-10)
4.
SEPARATE STEERING SLIDING YOKE SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Fix the steering wheel with the seat belt in order to
prevent rotation and damage to the spiral cable.
G029446E06
(b) Put matchmarks in the sliding yoke and
intermediate shaft.
(c) Loosen the bolt labeled A and remove the bolt
labeled B to separate the sliding yoke.
Matchmark
Bolt A
Bolt B
G029896E03
5.
DISCONNECT NO. 1 STEERING COLUMN HOLE
COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the clip labeled A and disconnect the hole
cover from the body.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the clip labeled B.
6.
REMOVE FRONT WHEELS
7.
DISCONNECT NO. 2 TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY
(See page DS-6)
8.
DISCONNECT NO. 1 TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY
HINT:
Use the same procedure described for the No. 2 tie rod
end.
9.
REMOVE FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY LH
(See page SP-28)
Clip A
Clip B
G028294E02
PS
10. REMOVE FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY RH
HINT:
Use the same procedure described for the LH.
POWER STEERING – STEERING GEAR
PS–51
11. REMOVE FRONT NO. 1 STABILIZER BRACKET LH
(See page SP-28)
12. REMOVE FRONT NO. 1 STABILIZER BRACKET RH
HINT:
Use the same procedure described for the LH.
Intermediate Shaft
Matchmark
G028290E03
for LH Side
13. REMOVE STEERING INTERMEDIATE SHAFT
(a) Move the No. 1 column hole cover to the upper side
of the vehicle and put matchmarks on the
intermediate shaft and steering gear.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the No. 1 hole cover when
moving it.
(b) Remove the bolt and remove the intermediate shaft
from the inside of the vehicle.
(c) Remove the No. 1 column hole cover from the
steering gear.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the No. 1 hole cover clip.
14. REMOVE STEERING GEAR ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 4 bolts and steering gear from the left
side of the vehicle.
HINT:
Be careful not to hit the stabilizer bar when
removing the steering gear.
for RH Side
G028292E04
DISASSEMBLY
SST
1.
FIX STEERING GEAR ASSEMBLY
(a) Using SST wrapped with protective tape, secure the
steering gear in a vise.
SST 09612-00012
HINT:
Remove and reinstall the SST as needed.
2.
REMOVE TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Put matchmarks on the tie rod end LH and rack end.
(b) Remove the tie rod end LH and lock nut.
3.
REMOVE TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
HINT:
Use the same procedure described for the LH.
4.
REMOVE STEERING RACK BOOT CLIP
(a) Using pliers, remove the 2 rack boot clips (for RH
and LH).
Vinyl Tape
G028295E03
Matchmark
F040050E12
PS
PS–52
POWER STEERING – STEERING GEAR
5.
REMOVE NO. 2 STEERING RACK BOOT CLAMP
(a) Using a screwdriver, unstake and remove the
clamp.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the boot.
6.
REMOVE NO. 1 STEERING RACK BOOT CLAMP
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the No. 2 rack
boot clamp.
7.
REMOVE NO. 2 STEERING RACK BOOT
8.
REMOVE NO. 1 STEERING RACK BOOT
9.
REMOVE STEERING RACK END SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Using 2 SST, remove the rack end (for LH side).
SST 09922-10010
NOTICE:
• Use SST in the correct direction as shown in
the illustration.
• Securely hold the steering rack.
G029447E02
for LH
SST
SST
G028298E04
(b) Using 2 SST, hold the steering rack LH side and
remove the rack end (for RH side).
SST 09922-10010
NOTICE:
• Use SST in the correct direction as shown in
the illustration.
• Securely hold the steering rack.
for RH
SST
SST
G028299E04
PS
POWER STEERING – STEERING GEAR
PS–53
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Secure the tie rod end LH boll join in a vise through
aluminum plates.
NOTICE:
Do not overtighten the vise.
(b) Install the castle nut to the stud bolt.
(c) Flip the ball joint back and forth 5 times or more.
(d) Set a torque wrench to the nut, turn the ball joint
continuously at a rate of 3 to 5 seconds per turn,
and check the turning torque on the 5th turn.
Standard turning torque:
2.0 N*m (20.4 kgf*cm, 18 in. lbf) or less
If turning torque is out of specification, replace the
tie rod end LH with a new one.
2.
INSPECT TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
3.
INSPECT TOTAL PRELOAD
(a) Using SST, inspect the total preload.
SST 09616-00011
Standard total preload (turning):
0.6 to 1.2 N*m (6.2 to 12.2 kgf*cm, 5 to 11
in.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Inspect around the steering rack center
position.
If the total preload is out of specification, replace the
steering gear with a new one.
SST
G028296E03
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL STEERING RACK END SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Fill up the ball joints of the RH and LH rack ends
with molybdenum disulfide lithium base grease.
G029137E02
for RH Side
Fulcrum
Length
SST
SST
G028300E04
(b) Using 2 SST, hold the steering rack LH side and
install the rack end (for RH side).
SST 09922-10010
Torque: 60 N*m (612 kgf*cm, 44 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
• Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of
345 mm (13.58 in.).
• Use SST in the correct direction as shown in
the illustration.
• Securely hold the steering rack.
PS
PS–54
POWER STEERING – STEERING GEAR
(c) Using 2 SST, install the rack end (for LH side).
SST 09922-10010
Torque: 60 N*m (612 kgf*cm, 44 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
• Use a torque wrench with a fulcrum length of
345 mm (13.58 in.).
• Use SST in the correct direction as shown in
the illustration.
• Securely hold the steering rack.
Fulcrum
Length
for LH Side
SST
G028302E04
2.
INSTALL NO. 2 STEERING RACK BOOT
(a) Apply silicon grease to the inside of the small
opening of the boot.
(b) Install the boot in the groove on the rack housing.
NOTICE:
Make sure that the boot is not twisted.
3.
INSTALL NO. 1 STEERING RACK BOOT
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the No. 2 boot.
4.
INSTALL NO. 2 STEERING RACK BOOT CLAMP
(a) Install a new clamp to the boot.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the boot.
(b) While pushing SST to the rack housing, pinch the
clamp so that the clearance is within specification.
SST 09521-24010
Standard clearance:
3.0 mm (0.12 in.) or less
NOTICE:
Make sure that the boot is not twisted.
5.
INSTALL NO. 1 STEERING RACK BOOT CLAMP
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the No. 2 rack
boot clamp.
6.
INSTALL STEERING RACK BOOT CLIP
(a) Using pliers, install the 2 rack boot clips to the RH
and LH rack boots.
7.
INSPECT STEERING GEAR ASSEMBLY
(a) Using SST, turn the pinion shaft and check that the
RH and LH rack boots expand and contract
smoothly, reinstall it with a new rack boot clamp.
SST 09616-00011
If the rack boot does not expand and contract
smoothly, reinstall it with a new rack boot clamp.
C057755E02
3.0 mm (0.12 in.) or less
F040084E02
SST
PS
G028297E02
POWER STEERING – STEERING GEAR
PS–55
8.
INSTALL TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Screw the lock nut and tie rod end LH on the rack
end unit the matchmarks are aligned and
temporarily tighten the lock nut.
HINT:
Fully tighten the lock nut after adjusting toe-in.
9.
REMOVE TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
Matchmark
F040050E13
for LH Side
INSTALLATION
for RH Side
1.
INSTALL STEERING GEAR ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the steering gear from the left side of the
vehicle.
HINT:
Be careful not to hit the stabilizer bar when installing
the steering gear.
(b) Install the No. 1 column hole cover to the steering
gear.
(c) Install the steering gear to the crossmember with
the 4 bolts.
Torque: 58 N*m (591 kgf*cm, 43 ft.*lbf)
2.
INSTALL STEERING INTERMEDIATE SHAFT
(a) Move the No. 1 column hole cover to the upper side
of the vehicle, align the matchmarks, and install the
intermediate shaft from the inside of the vehicle.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the No. 1 hole cover when
moving it.
(b) Install the bolt.
Torque: 35 N*m (360 kgf*cm, 26 ft.*lbf)
(c) Fit the recessed part on the No. 1 column hole cover
to the steering gear.
NOTICE:
Make sure that the No. 1 hole cover is securely
installed.
3.
INSTALL FRONT NO. 1 STABILIZER BRACKET LH
(See page SP-29)
4.
INSTALL FRONT NO. 1 STABILIZER BRACKET RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
5.
INSTALL FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY LH
(See page SP-30)
6.
INSTALL FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
7.
CONNECT NO. 1 TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY (See
page DS-16)
G028292E04
Intermediate
Shaft
Matchmark
G028290E04
PS
PS–56
POWER STEERING – STEERING GEAR
Clip A
Clip B
8.
CONNECT NO. 2 TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the No. 1 tie rod
end.
9.
INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
Torque: 103 N*m (1,050 kgf*cm, 76 ft.*lbf)
10. INSTALL NO. 1 STEERING COLUMN HOLE COVER
SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the clip labeled B to the vehicle body and
install the No. 1 column hole cover to the vehicle
body with the clip labeled A.
NOTICE:
Make sure that the lip of the No. 1 hole cover fits
on the dash panel correctly.
G028294E03
11. INSTALL STEERING SLIDING YOKE SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Align the matchmarks and install the sliding yoke to
the intermediate shaft with the bolt labeled B.
Torque: 35 N*m (360 kgf*cm, 26 ft.*lbf)
(b) Tighten the bolt labeled A.
Torque: 35 N*m (360 kgf*cm, 26 ft.*lbf)
Matchmark
Bolt A
Bolt B
12. INSTALL COLUMN HOLE COVER SILENCER SHEET
G029896E04
13. REPLACE FRONT WHEELS FACING STRAIGHT
AHEAD
14. INSPECT AND ADJUST FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
(a) Inspect and adjust the front wheel alignment (see
page SP-2).
15. PERFORM STEERING ANGLE SENSOR ZERO POINT
CALIBRATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
PS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–1
AIRBAG SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
CAUTION:
• The vehicle is equipped with a Supplemental Restraint
System (SRS), which consists of a steering pad, front
passenger airbag, curtain shield airbag, front seat side
airbag, seat belt pretensioner, center airbag sensor,
front airbag sensor, side airbag sensor, rear airbag
sensor, occupant classification ECU and seat position
airbag sensor. Failure to carry out service procedures
in the correct sequence could cause SRS parts to
unexpectedly deploy and possibly lead to serious
injuries. Furthermore, if a mistake is made when
service SRS parts, they may fail to operate when
required. Before performing servicing (including
installation/removal, inspection and replacement of
parts), be sure to read the following precautions.
• Before starting work, wait at least 90 seconds after the
power switch is turned OFF and after the cable of the
negative (-) battery terminal is disconnected. (SRS
parts are equipped with a back-up power source. If
work is started within 90 seconds of turning the power
switch OFF and disconnecting the cable from the
negative (-) battery terminal, SRS parts may deploy.)
(The SRS is equipped with a back-up power source, so
if work is started within 90 seconds of disconnecting
the negative (-) terminal cable of the battery, the SRS
may be deployed).
• Do not expose the steering pad, front passenger
airbag, center airbag sensor, front airbag sensor, front
seat inner belt, seat position airbag sensor, occupant
classification ECU, front seat airbag, side airbag
sensor, curtain shield airbag, rear seat airbag, rear
airbag sensor, front seat outer belt or rear seat outer
belt directly to hot air or flames.
NOTICE:
• Malfunction symptoms of SRS parts are difficult to
confirm. DTCs are the most important source of
information when troubleshooting. During
troubleshooting, always confirm DTCs before
disconnecting the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal.
• Even in the case of a minor collision when the SRS
does not deploy, the steering pad, front passenger
airbag, center airbag sensor, front airbag sensor, front
seat inner belt, seat position airbag sensor, occupant
classification ECU, front seat airbag, side airbag
sensor, curtain shield airbag, rear seat airbag, rear
airbag sensor, front seat outer belt or rear seat outer
belt should be inspected.
• Before repair work, remove airbag sensors as
necessary if any kind of impact is likely to occur to an
airbag sensor during the operation.
RS
RS–2
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
• Never use SRS parts from another vehicle. When
replacing SRS parts, replace them with new ones.
• Never disassemble or attempt to repair SRS parts.
• If an SRS part has been dropped, or if there are any
cracks, dents or other defects in the case, bracket or
connector, replace the SRS part with a new one.
• Use an ohmmeter/voltmeter with high impedance (10
kΩ/V minimum) for troubleshooting the electrical
circuits.
• Information labels are attached to the periphery of
SRS parts. Follow the cautions and instructions on the
labels.
• After work on SRS parts is completed, perform the
SRS warning light check (see page RS-31).
• When the cable is disconnected from the negative (-)
battery terminal, the memory settings of each system
will be cleared. Because of this, be sure to write down
the settings of each system before starting work.
When work is finished, reset the settings of each
system as before. Never use a back-up power supply
from outside the vehicle to avoid erasing the memory
in a system.
• If the vehicle is equipped with a mobile
communication system, refer to the precaution in the
INTRODUCTION section (see page IN-5).
• When disconnecting the cable from the negative (-)
battery terminal, initialize the following system(s) after
the cable is reconnected.
RS
System Name
Power Window Control System
See procedure
IN-32
HINT:
In the airbag system, the center airbag sensor, front airbag
sensor LH and RH, side airbag sensor LH and RH, rear
airbag sensor LH and RH are collectively referred to as the
airbag sensors.
1. HANDLING PRECAUTIONS FOR AIRBAG SENSORS
(a) Before starting the following operations, wait for at
least 90 seconds after disconnecting the negative () terminal cable from the battery:
(1) Replacement of the airbag sensors.
(2) Adjustment of the front/rear doors of the vehicle
equipped with the side airbag and curtain shield
airbag (fitting adjustment).
(b) When connecting or disconnecting the airbag
sensor connectors, ensure that each sensor is
installed in the vehicle.
(c) Do not use the airbag sensors which has been
dropped during the operation or transportation.
(d) Do not disassemble the airbag sensors.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
2.
RS–3
INSPECTION PROCEDURE FOR VEHICLE INVOLVED
IN ACCIDENT
(a) When the airbag has not deployed, confirm the
DTCs by checking the SRS warning light. If there is
any malfunction in the SRS airbag system, perform
troubleshooting.
(b) When any of the airbags have deployed, replace the
airbag sensors and check the installation condition.
RS
RS–4
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
3.
RS
SRS CONNECTORS
(a) SRS connectors are located as shown in the
following illustration.
7
Front Airbag Sensor LH
5
6
8
Steering Pad (Driver Side Squib)
11
9
Spiral Cable
10
12
HV ECU
13
14
Rear Airbag Sensor LH
15
16
Seat Position Sensor
17
18
Front Seat Side Airbag LH
(Side Squib LH)
19
20
Front Seat Outer Belt LH
(Front Pretensioner Squib LH)
21
4
3
2
1
4
3
22
Center Airbag Sensor
Side Airbag Sensor LH
23
24
Curtain Shield Airbag LH
(Curtain Shield Squib LH)
25
26
C132223E01
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
7
5
RS–5
Front Airbag Sensor RH
6
8
RS
29
27
28
Front Passenger Airbag
(Front Passenger Side Squib)
30
31
Passenger Airbag ON/OFF Indicator
32
15
Rear Airbag Sensor RH
16
33
Occupant Classification ECU
34
19
Front Seat Side Airbag RH
(Side Squib RH)
20
3
4
1
2
3
4
21
Front Seat Outer Belt RH
(Front Pretensioner Squib RH)
22
Center Airbag Sensor
23
Side Airbag Sensor RH
24
25
Curtain Shield Airbag RH
(Curtain Shield Squib RH)
26
C132224E01
No.
Item
Application
(1)
Terminal Twin-Lock Mechanism
Connectors 2, 4, 5, 6, 7, 9, 15, 23, 24
(2)
Activation Prevention Mechanism
Connectors 2, 4, 10, 12, 20, 22, 26, 28, 30
(3)
Half Connection Prevention Mechanism
Connectors 6, 7, 9, 15, 19, 23, 27
RS–6
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
No.
Item
Application
(4)
Connector Lock Mechanism (1)
(5)
Connector Lock Mechanism (2)
Connector 2, 4
(6)
Improper Connection Prevention Lock Mechanism
Connector 1, 3
RS
Spacer
Housing
Female
Male
Z005953E02
● When Connector is Connected
Connectors 11, 21, 25, 29
(b) All connectors in the SRS, except the seat position
airbag sensor connector, are colored yellow to
distinguish them from other connectors. These
connectors have special functions, and are specially
designed for the SRS. All SRS connectors use
durable gold-plated terminals, and are placed in the
locations shown above to ensure high reliability.
(1) Terminal twin-lock mechanism:
All connectors with a terminal twin-lock
mechanism have a two-piece component
consisting of a housing and a spacer. This
design enables the terminal to be locked
securely by two locking devices (the retainer and
the lance) to prevent terminals from coming out.
(2) Activation prevention mechanism:
All connectors with an activation prevention
mechanism contain a short spring plate. When
these connectors are disconnected, the short
spring plate creates a short circuit by
automatically connecting the positive (+) and
negative (-) terminals of the squib.
● When Connector is Disconnected
Short Spring Plate
Short Spring Plate
Housing
Contacting Male
Terminal
Housing
Short Spring Plate ON
Terminal
Squib
Connectors
Short Spring Plate
Squib
Closed Circuit
R010587E02
RS–7
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
(3) Half connection prevention mechanism:
If the connector is not completely connected, the
connector is disconnected due to the spring
operation so that no continuity exists.
Locking Part
Stopper
Locking Arm
Spring
Slider
Stopper
RS
Rebounded by Slider (Spring)
H040180E02
(4) Connector position assurance mechanism:
Only when the housing lock (white part) is
completely engaged, the CPA (yellow part)
slides, which completes the connector
engagement.
Housing Lock (White Part)
CPA (Yellow Part)
H043306E02
(5) Connector lock mechanism (1):
Locking the connector lock button connects the
connector securely.
Lock Button
Claw
Groove
H040181E04
RS–8
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
(6) Connector lock mechanism (2):
Both the primary lock with holder lances and the
secondary lock with retainer prevent the
connectors from being disconnected.
Holder
RS
Lance
Retainer
Retainer
H043918E01
(7) Improper connection prevention lock
mechanism:
When connecting the holder, the lever is pushed
into the end by rotating around the A axis to lock
the holder securely.
A
A
Lever
H043245E01
RS–9
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
4.
Lock Button
(Yellow part)
Lock Button
(Yellow part)
(a)
DISCONNECTION OF CONNECTORS FOR
STEERING PAD, FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG
(SQUIB SIDE), CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG AND
FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(a) Release the lock button (yellow part) of the
connector using a screwdriver.
(b) Insert the screwdriver tip between the connector
and the base, and then raise the connector.
Mark
H042906E04
5.
CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS FOR STEERING
PAD, FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG (SQUIB SIDE),
CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG AND FRONT SEAT
OUTER BELT
(a) Connect the connector.
RS
RS–10
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
(b) Push down securely on the lock button (yellow part)
of the connector. When locking, a click sound can
be heard.
RS
Lock Button
(Yellow part)
H043151E04
6.
Slider
DISCONNECTION OF CONNECTOR FOR FRONT
PASSENGER AIRBAG (INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
SIDE)
(a) Place a finger on the slider, slide the slider to
release the lock, and then disconnect the connector.
Slider
Disconnection is completed
H001586E02
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
7.
RS–11
CONNECTION OF CONNECTOR FOR FRONT
PASSENGER AIRBAG (INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
SIDE)
(a) Connect the connector as shown in the illustration.
When locking, make sure that the slider returns to
its original position and a click sound can be heard.
HINT:
When connecting, the slider will slide. Be sure not to
touch the slider while connecting, as it may result in
an insecure fit.
Slider
Slider
Connection is completed
H043731E02
8.
Slider
DISCONNECTION OF CONNECTORS FOR FRONT
SEAT AIRBAG
(a) Place a finger on the slider, slide the slider to
release the lock, and then disconnect the connector.
Slider
Disconnect is completed
H001584E09
RS
RS–12
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
9.
RS
CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS FOR FRONT SEAT
AIRBAG
(a) Connect the connector as shown in the illustration.
When locking, make sure that the slider returns to
its original position and a click sound can be heard.
HINT:
When connecting, the slider will slide. Be sure not to
touch the slider while connecting, as it may result in
an insecure fit.
Slider
Slider
Connection is completed
H043169E02
10. DISCONNECTION OF CONNECTOR FOR CENTER
AIRBAG SENSOR
(a) Pull the lever by pushing part A as shown in the
illustration and disconnect the holder (with
connectors).
A
Holder (with connectors)
Disconnection is completed
H045112E01
HINT:
Perform the following procedures when replacing
the holder.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–13
(b) Remove the holder.
(1) Using a screwdriver, unlock the retainer.
RS
Retainer
H043188E01
(2) Release the fitting lance and remove the holder.
Lances
H043189E01
H043190E01
(c) Install the holder.
(1) Install the connectors to the holder. When
locking, a click sound can be heard.
HINT:
The retainer is locked when the holder is
connected.
11. CONNECTION OF CONNECTOR FOR CENTER
AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Firmly insert the holder (with connectors) into the
center airbag sensor until it cannot be pushed any
further.
RS–14
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
(b) Push the lever to connect the holder (with
connectors). When locking, a click sound can be
heard.
HINT:
The holder slides in to the center airbag sensor
when it is being connected. Be sure not to hold the
holder while connecting, as it may result in an
insecure fit.
RS
Holder (with connectors)
Lever
Connection is completed
H045113E01
12. DISCONNECTION OF CONNECTOR FOR FRONT
AIRBAG SENSOR
(a) Push down the housing lock (white part) and slide
the CPA (yellow part). At this time, the connector
cannot be disconnected yet.
(b) Push down the housing lock (white part) again and
disconnect the connector.
HINT:
Do not push down the A part shown in the
illustration when disconnecting.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–15
A
Housing Lock (White Part)
Connector
lock is
released
CPA (Yellow Part)
H043302E02
(c) After disconnecting the connector, check that the
position of the housing lock (white part) is as shown
in the illustration.
H043303E02
RS
RS–16
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
13. CONNECTION OF CONNECTOR FOR FRONT
AIRBAG SENSOR
(a) Before connecting the connectors, check that the
position of the housing lock (white part) is as shown
in the illustration.
RS
H043304E01
(b) Be sure to engage the connectors until they are
locked. When locking, make sure that a click sound
can be heard.
HINT:
When connecting them, the housing lock (white
part) slides. Be sure not to hold the housing lock
(white part) and part A, as it may result in an
insecure fit.
A
Housing Lock (White Part)
CPA (Yellow Part)
Connection is completed
H043305E02
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
Outer
H002763E02
RS–17
14. DISCONNECTION OF CONNECTORS FOR SIDE
AIRBAG SENSOR AND REAR AIRBAG SENSOR
(a) While holding both the sides of the outer connector
locking sleeve, slide the outer in the direction shown
by the arrow.
(b) When the connector lock is released, the
connectors are disconnected.
HINT:
Be sure to hold both outer flank sides. Holding the
top and bottom will make disconnection difficult.
Connector lock is released
Disconnection is completed
H002764E02
15. CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS FOR SIDE AIRBAG
SENSOR AND REAR AIRBAG SENSOR
(a) Connect the connector as shown in the illustration
When locking, make sure that the outer returns to its
original position and a click sound can be heard.
HINT:
When connecting, the outer will slide. Be sure not to
hold the outer while connecting, as it may result in
an insecure fit.
Outer
Outer
Connection is completed
H002768E02
RS
RS–18
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
RS
REAR AIRBAG SENSOR
SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR
FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR
C123569E02
RS–19
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS
CURTAIN SHIELD
AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
FRONT SEAT SIDE
AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
FRONT SEAT OUTER
BELT ASSEMBLY RH
FRONT SEAT OUTER
BELT ASSEMBLY LH
SEAT POSITION SENSOR
FRONT SEAT INNER
BELT ASSEMBLY
OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
C123571E02
RS–20
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
COMBINATION METER
SRS WARNING LIGHT
FRONT PASSENGER
AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
SPIRAL CABLE
DLC3
STEERING PAD
CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
C123570E02
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–21
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
Steering Pad (Driver Side Squib)
Front Airbag Sensor LH
RS
Front Passenger Airbag
(Driver Side Squib)
Front Airbag Sensor RH
Side Airbag Sensor LH
Front Seat Airbag LH
(Driver Side Squib LH)*
Side Airbag Sensor RH
Front Seat Airbag RH
(Front Passenger Side Squib RH)*
Rear Airbag Sensor LH
Rear Airbag Sensor RH
Center
Airbag
Sensor
Curtain Shield Airbag LH
(Driver Side Squib LH)*
Seat Position Airbag Sensor
Curtain Shield Airbag RH
(Front Passenger Side Squib RH)*
Front Seat Inner Belt LH
Occupant Classification ECU
Front Seat Outer Belt LH
(Driver Side Pretensioner LH)
Front Seat Outer Belt RH
(Front Passenger Pretensioner RH)
Passenger Airbag ON/OFF Indicator
Combination Meter
HV ECU
*: w/ Side Airbag and Curtain Shield Airbag
DLC3
C123547E02
RS–22
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
RS
2.
SRS AIRBAG SYSTEM OUTLINE
(a) FRONTAL COLLISION
(1) The driver and front passenger airbag are
designed to supplement seat belts in the event
of a front collision in order to help reduce shock
to the head and chest of the driver and front
passenger.
(2) Frontal collisions are detected by the center
airbag sensor and two front airbag sensors. The
driver and front passenger airbag and the seat
belt pretensioner then operate simultaneously.
(3) Electrical deceleration sensors are built into the
two front airbag sensors in the engine
compartment in order to detect the severity of
the impact during the initial stage of the collision.
The deployment of the driver and front
passenger airbags are controlled in two stages
according to the severity of the impact.
(b) SIDE COLLISION
(1) The front seat airbag and curtain shield airbag
are designed to help reduce shock to the driver,
front passenger and rear outer passenger. The
curtain shield airbag was designed to help
reduce shock to the front and rear passengers in
the event of a side collision.
(2) Side collisions are detected by the side airbag
sensor installed in the bottom of the center pillar
and the airbag sensor rear installed in the
bottom of the rear pillar. Front side collisions are
detected by the side airbag sensor, causing the
front seat airbag and curtain shield airbag to
deploy simultaneously. Rear side collisions are
detected by the airbag sensor rear to deploy
only the curtain shield airbag.
CONSTRUCTION AND OPERATION
(a) FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR
(1) The front airbag sensors are installed on the
right and left side members.
(2) The deceleration sensor and safing sensor are
built into the airbag sensor front and distortion
that is created in the sensor is converted into an
electric signal based on the vehicle deceleration
rate during a frontal collision. Accordingly, the
extent of the initial collision can be detected in
detail.
(b) SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR
(1) The side airbag sensors are installed on the right
and left center pillars.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–23
(2) The side airbag sensor consists of the
deceleration sensor, safing sensor, ignition
control circuit, and diagnostic circuit. The side
airbag sensor receives signals from the
deceleration sensor and determines whether the
front seat airbag and curtain shield airbag should
be activated, and diagnoses system
malfunctions simultaneously.
(c) REAR AIRBAG SENSOR
(1) The rear airbag sensor is installed on the bottom
of the right and left rear pillars respectively.
(2) The deceleration sensor and safing sensor are
built into the rear airbag sensor and the
distortion that is created in the sensor is
converted into an electric signal based on the
vehicle deceleration rate during a rear side
collision.
(d) CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
(1) General
• The center airbag sensor is installed on the
center floor under the instrument panel.
• The center airbag sensor consists of the
deceleration sensor, safing sensor, electrical
safing sensor, ignition control circuit and
diagnostic circuit.
• The center airbag sensor receives signals
from the deceleration sensors and safing
sensors built into the center airbag sensor
and front airbag sensor.
• The center airbag sensor causes the front
seat side airbag and the curtain shield airbag
to deploy when receiving signals from the
deceleration sensor and the safing sensor
built into the side airbag sensor.
• The center airbag sensor receives signals
from the deceleration sensors and the
electrical safing sensors built into the center
airbag sensor and the rear airbag sensor, and
determines whether or not the curtain shield
airbag should be activated, and then
diagnoses system malfunctions.
• The center airbag sensor can be check using
check mode, which can detect and output
DTCs. If the malfunction does not recur
during troubleshooting, joggling each
connector or driving on various type of roads
with the center airbag sensor in check mode
as a simulation method makes it possible to
obtain more accurate information.
RS
RS–24
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
(2) Deceleration sensor and ignition control circuit
• The deceleration sensor is built into the
center airbag sensor, and the distortion
created based on the deceleration of the
vehicle during a frontal or rear side collision is
converted into an electric signal.
• The ignition control circuit performs
calculations based on the signal output from
the deceleration sensors of the center airbag
sensor and front airbag sensor. If the
calculated values are greater than the
specified values, the airbag deploy.
(3) Safing sensor
• The safing sensor is built into the center
airbag sensor. During a frontal collision, the
sensor turns on and outputs an ON signal to
the center airbag sensor if a deceleration rate
greater than the specified value is applied to
the safing sensor.
(4) Electronic safing sensor
• The electronic safing sensor is built into the
center airbag sensor. During a rear side
collision, the sensor turns on and outputs an
ON signal to the center airbag sensor if a
deceleration rate greater than the specified
value is applied to the electronic safing
sensor.
(5) Back-up power source
• The back-up power source consists of a
condenser and a DC-DC converter. When the
power system does not function during a
collision, the condenser discharges and
supplies electric power to the system. The
DC-DC converter operates as a boosting
transformer when the battery voltage falls
below a predetermined level.
(6) Diagnostic circuit
• This circuit constantly diagnoses the system
malfunctions. When a malfunction is
detected, it lights up the SRS warning light on
the combination meter to inform the driver.
(7) Memory circuit
• When a malfunction is detected in the
diagnostic circuit, it is coded and stored in the
memory circuit.
(e) SRS WARNING LIGHT
(1) The SRS warning light is located on the
combination meter. The SRS warning light
informs the driver of detected malfunctions in the
diagnostic circuit of the center airbag sensor or
the SRS airbag system. Under normal operating
conditions when the power switch is turned on,
the SRS warning light comes on for
approximately 6 seconds and then goes off.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
3.
RS–25
DEPLOYMENT CONDITION
When the vehicle collides and the shock is greater than
the specified value, the SRS is activated automatically.
The center airbag sensor includes the safing sensor and
deceleration sensor. The safing sensor was designed to
the turned on at a smaller deceleration rate than the
deceleration sensor.
(a) The center airbag sensor determines whether or not
ignition is necessary based on signals from the
deceleration sensor and the front airbag sensor*. If
the deceleration sensor, front airbag sensor* and
safing sensor turn on simultaneously, current flows
to the squibs to deploy the SRS as shown in the
illustration below.
Center Airbag Sensor
Safing Sensor ON
Steering Pad
AND
Front Passenger Airbag
Deceleration Sensor ON
Center Airbag Sensor
Safing Sensor ON
Steering Pad
AND
Front Passenger Airbag
Deceleration Sensor ON
AND
Front Airbag Sensor*
C
C109526E11
HINT:
*: In case of front collision, the ignition signal could
be output with the deceleration sensor ON signal
even without a signal from the front airbag sensor.
RS
RS–26
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
(b) The center airbag sensor determines whether or not
ignition is necessary based on signals from the side
airbag sensor. If the side airbag sensor and safing
sensor turn on simultaneously, current flows to the
squib to deploy the SRS as shown in the illustration
below.
RS
Safing Sensor
AND
Front Seat Airbag
Side Airbag Sensor
C
C109527E10
(c) The center airbag sensor determines whether or not
ignition is necessary based on signals from the rear
airbag sensor. If the rear airbag sensor and safing
sensor turn on simultaneously, current flows to the
squib to deploy the SRS as shown in the illustration
below.
Front Seat Airbag Deployment
Safing Sensor
Front Seat Side Airbag
OR
AND
Curtain Shield Airbag*
Rear Airbag Sensor*
C
C109528E10
HINT:
*: If the front seat airbag deploys, the curtain shield
airbag will also deploy, regardless of whether the
signal is output from the rear airbag sensor.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–27
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
• Use these procedures to troubleshoot the airbag system.
• *: Use the intelligent tester.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
INSPECT BATTERY VOLTAGE
Standard voltage:
11 to 14 V
If the voltage is below 11 V, recharge or replace the battery
before proceeding.
NEXT
3
CHECK MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM*
(a) Check the DTC (see page RS-38).
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC is not output
A
DTC is output
B
B
CHECK MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION
SYSTEM
A
4
CHECK CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM*
(a) Check the DTC (see page RS-38).
Result
Result
DTC is not output
A
DTC is output
B
B
A
5
NEXT
WARNING LIGHT CHECK
Proceed to
CHECK CAN COMMUNICATION CIRCUIT
RS
RS–28
6
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK DTC (Present and Past DTCs)*
(a) Check the DTC (see page RS-38).
Result
RS
Result
Proceed to
DTC is not output
A
DTC is output
B
B
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
A
7
DTC CHART
NEXT
8
CIRCUIT INSPECTION
NEXT
9
REPAIR
NEXT
10
CLEAR DTC (Present and Past DTCs)*
NEXT
11
CHECK DTC (Present and Past DTCs)*
(a) Check the DTC (see page RS-38).
Result
Result
DTC is not output
A
DTC is output
B
B
A
Proceed to
Go to step 6
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
12
RS–29
CONFIRMATION TEST
NEXT
RS
END
RS–30
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
• Use the table below to help determine the cause of the
problem symptom. The potential causes of the symptoms
are listed in order of probability in the "Suspected area"
column of the table. Check each symptom by checking the
suspected areas in the order they are listed. Replace parts
as necessary.
• Inspect the fuses and relays related to this system before
inspecting the suspected areas below.
RS
Airbag system
Symptom
Suspected area
See page
The SRS warning light sometimes comes on after
approximately 6 seconds when the power switch is ON
(IG).
SRS Warning Light Remains ON
RS-161
The SRS warning light remains on when DTC is not
output.
SRS Warning Light Remains ON
RS-161
The SRS warning light does not come on with the
power switch ON (IG).
SRS Warning Light does not Come ON
RS-165
SRS warning light blinks.
TC and CG Terminal Circuit
RS-167
DTC cannot read.
TC and CG Terminal Circuit
RS-167
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–31
TERMINALS OF ECU
RS
A17
A18
A19
C109532E08
Terminal No.
Terminal Symbol
Destination
A17-1
SFD+
Front seat side airbag LH (Side squib LH)
A17-2
SFD-
Front seat side airbag LH (Side squib LH)
A17-3
ICD-
Curtain shield airbag LH (Driver side curtain
shield squib)
A17-4
ICD+
Curtain shield airbag LH (Driver side curtain
shield squib)
A17-5
PD+
Front seat outer belt LH (Driver side
pretensioner squib)
A17-6
PD-
Front seat outer belt LH (Driver side
pretensioner squib)
A17-9
DSP+
Seat position sensor
A17-10
DBE+
Front seat inner belt LH
A17-17
DSP-
Seat position sensor
A17-18
DBE-
Front seat inner belt LH
A17-19
VUPD
Side airbag sensor LH
A17-20
VUCD
Rear airbag sensor LH
A17-21
ESD
Side airbag sensor LH
A17-22
ESCD
Rear airbag sensor LH
A18-1
P2+
Front passenger airbag (Front passenger side
squib 2nd step)
A18-2
P2-
Front passenger airbag (Front passenger side
squib 2nd step)
A18-3
P-
Front passenger airbag (Front passenger side
squib)
A18-4
P+
Front passenger airbag (Front passenger side
squib)
A18-5
D+
Steering pad (Driver side squib)
A18-6
D-
Steering pad (Driver side squib)
A18-7
D2-
Steering pad (Driver side squib 2nd step)
A18-8
D2+
Steering pad (Driver side squib 2nd step)
RS–32
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
Terminal No.
Terminal Symbol
Destination
A18-13
PBEW
Combination meter ECU
A18-14
LA
Combination meter
A18-15
TC
DLC3
A18-16
SIL
DLC3
A18-17
P-AB
Front passenger seat belt warning light
(Passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator)
A18-21
IG2
IGN fuse
A18-22
GSW2
HV ECU
A18-23
PAON
Front passenger seat belt warning light
(Passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator)
A18-25
E1
Ground
A18-26
E2
Ground
A18-27
-SR
Front airbag sensor RH
A18-28
-SL
Front airbag sensor LH
A18-29
+SR
Front airbag sensor RH
A18-30
+SL
Front airbag sensor LH
A19-3
PP-
Front seat outer belt RH (Front passenger
side pretensioner squib RH)
A19-4
PP+
Front seat outer belt RH (Front passenger
side pretensioner squib RH)
A19-5
ICP+
Curtain shield airbag RH (Curtain shield squib
RH)
A19-6
ICP-
Curtain shield airbag RH (Curtain shield squib
RH)
A19-7
SFP-
Front seat side airbag RH (Side squib RH)
A19-8
SFP+
Front seat side airbag RH (Side squib RH)
A19-16
FSP+
Occupant classification ECU
A19-19
ESCP
Side airbag sensor RH
A19-20
ESP
Rear airbag sensor RH
A19-21
VUCP
Side airbag sensor RH
A19-22
VUPP
Rear airbag sensor RH
A19-24
FSP-
Occupant classification ECU
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–33
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
1.
2.
CG SG CANH SIL
CANL
DESCRIPTION
The center airbag sensor controls the functions of the
Supplemental Restraint System (SRS) on the vehicle.
Data of the SRS can be read in the Data Link Connector
3 (DLC3) of the vehicle. When the system seems to be
malfunctioning, use the intelligent tester to check for a
malfunction and perform repairs.
CHECK DLC3
(a) The ECU uses ISO 15765-4 for communication.
The terminal arrangement of the DLC3 complies
with ISO 15031-3 and matches the ISO 15765-4
format.
BAT
H100769E16
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
SIL (7) - SG (5)
Bus "+" line
During transmission
Pulse generation
CG (4) - Body ground
Chassis ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
SG (5) - Body ground
Signal ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
BAT (16) - Body ground
Battery positive
Always
11 to 14 V
CANH (6) - CANL (14)
HIGH-Level CAN bus line
Power switch is OFF*
54 to 69 Ω
CANH (6) - Battery positive
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Power switch is OFF*
1 kΩ or more
CANH (6) - CG (4)
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Power switch is OFF*
1 kΩ or more
CANL (14) - Battery positive
LOW-level CAN bus line
Power switch is OFF*
1 MΩ or more
CANL (14) - CG (4)
LOW-level CAN bus line
Power switch is OFF*
1 MΩ or more
NOTICE:
*: Before measuring the resistance, leave the
vehicle as is for at least 1 minute and do not
operate the power switch, any other switches or
the doors.
If the result is not as specified, the DLC3 may have
a malfunction. Repair or replace the harness and
connector.
HINT:
Connect the cable of the intelligent tester (with CAN
VIM) to the DLC3, turn the power switch ON (IG)
and attempt to use the tester. If the display indicates
that a communication error has occurred, there is a
problem either with the vehicle or with the tester.
• If communication is normal when the tester is
connected to another vehicle, inspect the DLC3
on the original vehicle.
• If communication is still not possible when the
tool is connected to another vehicle, the problem
is probably in the tester itself. Consult the Service
Department listed in the tester's instruction
manual.
RS
RS–34
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
3.
RS
Vibrate Slightly
Shake Slightly
Vibrate Slightly
4.
D025083E02
SYMPTOM SIMULATION
HINT:
The most difficult case in troubleshooting is when no
problem symptoms occur. In such a case, a thorough
problem analysis must be carried out. A simulation of the
same or similar conditions and environment in which the
problem occurred in the customer's vehicle should be
carried out. No matter how much skill or experience a
technician has, troubleshooting without confirming the
problem symptoms will lead to important repairs being
overlooked and mistakes or delays.
(a) Vibration method: When vibration seems to be the
major cause.
HINT:
Perform the simulation method only during the
primary check period (for approximately 6 seconds
after the power switch ON (IG)).
(1) Slightly vibrate the part of the sensor considered
to be the problem cause with your fingers and
check whether the malfunction occurs.
HINT:
Shaking the relays too strongly may result in
open relays.
(2) Slightly shake the connector vertically and
horizontally.
(3) Slightly shake the wire harness vertically and
horizontally.
The connector joint and fulcrum of the vibration
are the major areas to be checked thoroughly.
FUNCTION OF SRS WARNING LIGHT
(a) Primary check.
(1) Turn the power switch OFF. Wait for at least 2
seconds, then turn the power switch ON (IG).
The SRS warning light comes on for
approximately 6 seconds and the diagnosis of
the airbag system (including the seat belt
pretensioners) is performed.
HINT:
If trouble is detected during the primary check,
the SRS warning light remains on even after the
primary check period (for approximately 6
seconds) has elapsed.
(b) Constant check.
(1) After the primary check, the center airbag sensor
constantly monitors the airbag system for
trouble.
HINT:
If trouble is detected during the constant check,
the center airbag sensor functions as follows:
• The SRS warning light comes on.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–35
• The SRS warning light goes off, and then
comes on. This blinking pattern indicates a
source voltage drop. The SRS warning light
goes off 10 seconds after the source voltage
returns to normal.
(c) Review.
(1) When the airbag system is normal:
The SRS warning light comes on only during the
primary check period (for approximately 6
seconds after the power switch is turned ON
(IG)).
(2) When the airbag system has trouble:
• The SRS warning light remains on even after
the primary check period has elapsed.
• The SRS warning light goes off after the
primary check, but comes on again during the
constant check.
• The SRS warning light does not come on
when turning the power switch from OFF to
ON (IG).
HINT:
The center airbag sensor keeps the SRS
warning light on if the airbag has been deployed.
5.
C093955E02
6.
SRS WARNING LIGHT CHECK
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and check that the
SRS warning light comes on for approximately 6
seconds (primary check).
(b) Check that the SRS warning light goes off
approximately 6 seconds after the power switch is
turned ON (IG) (constant check).
HINT:
When any of the following symptoms occur, refer to
the "Problem Symptoms Table" (see page RS-29).
• The SRS warning light comes on occasionally
after the primary check period has elapsed.
• The SRS warning light comes on, but a DTC is
not output.
• The power switch is turned from OFF to ON (IG),
but the SRS warning light does not come on.
ACTIVATION PREVENTION MECHANISM
(a) FUNCTION OF ACTIVATION PREVENTION
MECHANISM
(1) An activation prevention mechanism is built into
the connector on the center airbag sensor side
of the airbag system squib circuit to prevent
accidental airbag activation.
(2) This mechanism closes the circuit when the
connector is disconnected by bringing the short
spring into contact with the terminals and
shutting off external electricity to prevent
accidental airbag activation.
RS
RS–36
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
(b) RELEASE METHOD OF ACTIVATION
PREVENTION MECHANISM
(1) To release the activation prevention mechanism,
insert a piece of paper with the same thickness
as the male terminal (approximately 0.5 mm
(0.020 in.)) between the terminals and the short
spring to break the connection.
(2) Refer to the illustrations below concerning
connectors utilizing the activation prevention
mechanism and its release method.
CAUTION:
Never release the activation prevention
mechanism on the squib connector even
when inspecting with the squib
disconnected.
NOTICE:
• Do not release the activation prevention
mechanism unless specially directed by
the troubleshooting procedure.
• To prevent the terminal and the short
spring from being damaged, always use a
piece of paper of the same thickness as
the male terminal.
RS–37
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
7
Front Airbag Sensor LH
5
6
8
Steering Pad (Driver Side Squib)
RS
11
9
Spiral Cable
10
12
HV ECU
13
14
Rear Airbag Sensor LH
15
16
Seat Position Sensor
17
18
Front Seat Side Airbag LH
(Side Squib LH)
19
20
Front Seat Outer Belt LH
(Front Pretensioner Squib LH)
21
4
3
2
1
4
3
22
Center Airbag Sensor
Side Airbag Sensor LH
23
24
Curtain Shield Airbag LH
(Curtain Shield Squib LH)
25
26
C132223E01
RS–38
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
7
5
Front Airbag Sensor RH
6
8
RS
29
27
28
Front Passenger Airbag
(Front Passenger Side Squib)
30
31
Passenger Airbag ON/OFF Indicator
32
15
Rear Airbag Sensor RH
16
33
Occupant Classification ECU
34
19
Front Seat Side Airbag RH
(Side Squib RH)
20
3
4
1
2
3
4
21
Front Seat Outer Belt RH
(Front Pretensioner Squib RH)
22
Center Airbag Sensor
23
Side Airbag Sensor RH
24
25
Curtain Shield Airbag RH
(Curtain Shield Squib RH)
26
C132224E01
RS–39
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
Center Airbag Sensor Connector
Connector 4
Connector 4
Connector 2
RS
Short Spring
Short Spring
Short Spring
After Release
Before Release
Paper
Paper
Short Spring
Connector 10
Short Spring
After Release
Before Release
Paper
Short Spring
Paper
Short Spring
Short Spring
Connector 28
After Release
Before Release
Short Spring
Short Spring
Paper
C
Short Spring
Paper
C109538E04
DTC CHECK / CLEAR
1.
CG
DLC3
TC
H100769E50
CHECK DTC (USING SST CHECK WIRE)
(a) Check for DTCs (Present DTC).
(1) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for
approximately 60 seconds.
(2) Using SST, connect terminals 13 (TC) and 4
(CG) of the DLC3.
SST 09843-18040
RS–40
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
NOTICE:
Connect the terminals to the correct
positions to avoid a malfunction.
(b) Check for DTCs (Past DTC).
(1) Using SST, connect terminals 13 (TC) and 4
(CG) of the DLC3.
SST 09843-18040
NOTICE:
Connect the terminals to the correct
positions to avoid a malfunction.
(2) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for
approximately 60 seconds.
RS
Normal System Code (without Past
Trouble Code)
0.25 sec.
ON
OFF
0.25 sec.
Normal System Code
(with Past Trouble Code)
0.75 sec.
ON
OFF
0.25 sec.
DTC (Example DTCs 11 and 31)
0.5 sec. 2.5 sec.
4.0 sec.
1.5 sec. 0.5 sec.
DTC 11
2.
Repeat
DTC 31
H100355E02
(c) Read the DTCs.
(1) Read the blinking patterns of the DTCs. As
examples, the blinking patterns for the normal
system code and DTCs 11 and 31 are shown in
the illustration.
• Normal system code indication (without past
DTC)
The light blinks twice per second.
• Normal system code indication (with past
DTC)
When the past DTC is stored in the center
airbag sensor, the light blinks once per
second.
• DTC indication
The first blinking pattern indicates the first
digit DTC. The second blinking pattern occurs
after a 1.5-second pause.
If there are 2 or more DTCs, there is a 2.5second pause between each DTC. After all
DTCs are shown, there is a 4.0-second pause,
and they are all repeated.
HINT:
• If 2 or more malfunctions are found, the
indication begins with the lowest numbered
DTC.
• If DTCs are indicated without connecting the
terminals, proceed to the "TC and CG
Terminal Circuit" (see page RS-167).
CLEAR DTC (USING SST CHECK WIRE)
(a) Clear the DTCs.
(1) When the power switch is turned OFF, the DTCs
are cleared.
HINT:
Depending on the DTCs, the DTCs may not all
be cleared by turning off the power switch. In this
case, proceed to the next step.
(2) Using SST, connect terminals 13 (TC) and 4
(CG) of the DLC3, and then turn the power
switch on.
SST 09843-18040
RS–41
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
(3) Disconnect terminal 13 (TC) of the DLC3 within
3 to 10 seconds after the DTCs are output, and
check that the SRS warning light comes on after
3 seconds.
(4) Within 2 to 4 seconds of the SRS warning light
coming on, connect terminals 13 (TC) and 4
(CG) of the DLC3.
(5) The SRS warning light goes off within 2 to 4
seconds of connecting terminals 13 (TC) and 4
(CG) of the DLC3. Then, disconnect terminal 13
(TC) within 2 to 4 seconds of the SRS warning
light going off.
(6) The SRS warning light comes on again within 2
to 4 seconds of disconnecting terminal 13 (TC).
Then, reconnect terminals 13 (TC) and 4 (CG)
within 2 to 4 seconds of the SRS warning light
coming on.
(7) Check that the SRS warning light goes off within
2 to 4 seconds of connecting terminals 13 (TC)
and 4 (CG) of the DLC3. Also check that the
normal system code is output within 1 second of
the SRS warning light going off.
If DTCs are not cleared, repeat these procedure
until the DTCs are cleared.
ON (IG)
Power Switch
OFF
Open
DLC3 (TC and CG)
Short
SRS Warning Light*
T1: Preparation time
0.5
0.5
0.25
0.25
ON
OFF
1.5
T2: Approximately 6 seconds
T3: 3 to 5 seconds
T4: 3 to 10 seconds
T1
T2
T3
T4
T5 T6 T5 T6 T5 T6 T5 T7
T5: 2 to 4 seconds
(seconds)
T6: 1 to 5 seconds
T7: Within 1 second
C
*: The past DTC in the illustration shows DTC 21 as an example.
C109537E12
RS
RS–42
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
3.
Intelligent Tester
RS
4.
DLC3
CAN VIM
B126098E01
CHECK DTC (USING INTELLIGENT TESTER)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Check the DTCs by following the prompts on the
tester screen.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual for
further details.
CLEAR DTC (USING INTELLIGENT TESTER)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Clear the DTCs by following the prompts on the
tester screen.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual for
further details.
CHECK MODE PROCEDURE
Intelligent Tester
1.
DLC3
CAN VIM
B126098E01
CHECK MODE (SIGNAL CHECK): DTC CHECK
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Select the SIGNAL CHECK, and proceed to check
with the intelligent tester.
NOTICE:
Select the SIGNAL CHECK from the DTC CHECK
screen displayed on the intelligent tester to
clear the output DTCs (both present and past).
HINT:
• DTCs can be detected more sensitively in check
mode than in normal diagnosis mode.
• Perform the check mode inspection when a
malfunction in each squib circuit is suspected
even after the normal system code is output
through the normal diagnosis mode inspection.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–43
DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST
1.
READ DATA LIST
HINT:
Using the intelligent tester's DATA LIST allows switch,
sensor, actuator and other item values to be read without
removing any parts. Reading the DATA LIST early in
troubleshooting is one way to save time.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Read the DATA LIST according to the display on the
tester.
Center airbag sensor:
Item
Measure Item/
Range (Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
D SEAT POSITION
Seat position (Driver side)/
FORWARD: Seat position
forward
BKWARD: Seat position
backward
FAIL: Failure detected
FORWARD/BKWARD
-
PASSENGER CLASS
Front passenger classification/
NG: Data is not determined
OFF: Vacant
CHILD: Child (Less than 36 kg
[79.37 lb]) seated
AF05: Adult (36 to 54 kg [79.37 to
119.05 lb]) seated
AM50: Adult (More than 54 kg
[119.05 lb]) seated
FAIL: Failure detected
NG/OFF/CHILD/AF05/AM50/
FAIL
-
D BUCKLE SW
Buckle switch (Driver side)/
UNSET: Seat belt not fastened
SET: Seat belt fastened
NG: Data not determined
UNSET/SET
-
P BUCKLE SW
Buckle switch (Front passenger
side)/
UNSET: Seat belt not fastened
SET: Seat belt fastened
NG: Data not determined
UNSET/SET
-
DISPLAY TYPE
Display type identification
information/
LR: Display indicated by LH/RH
DP: Display indicated by Driver/
Passenger
DP
-
PAST CODES
Number of past DTCs/
Min.: 0, Max.: 255
0
-
RS
RS–44
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
If a DTC is displayed during the DTC check, check the circuit
listed for the DTC in the table below.
HINT:
• When the SRS warning light remains on and the normal
system code is output, a decrease in the source voltage is
likely to occur. This malfunction is not stored in the
memory of the center airbag sensor. If the power source
voltage returns to normal, the SRS warning light will
automatically go off.
• When 2 or more DTCs are indicated, the DTC with the
lowest number appears first.
• If a DTC is not listed on the DTC chart, the center airbag
sensor may have malfunction.
• In the case of any malfunctions concerning open circuits,
shorts to ground, or shorts to B+ due to squibs, other
DTCs may not be set. In this case, repair the malfunction
currently indicated and then perform malfunction diagnosis
again.
• Mark in the check mode column:
-: DTC does not correspond to check mode.
{: DTC corresponds to check mode.
• When DTC B1650/32 is set as a result of troubleshooting
the Supplemental Restraint System (SRS), perform
troubleshooting for the occupant classification system.
RS
Airbag system:
DTC No.
Detection Item
Check Mode
SRS Warning Light
See page
B1000/31
Center Airbag Sensor
Assembly Malfunction
-
ON
RS-46
B1610/13
Front Airbag Sensor RH
Circuit Malfunction
-
ON
RS-47
B1615/14
Front Airbag Sensor LH
Circuit Malfunction
-
ON
RS-56
B1620/21
Driver Side - Side Airbag
Sensor Circuit Malfunction
-
ON
RS-65
B1625/22
Front Passenger Side Side Airbag Sensor Circuit
Malfunction
-
ON
RS-70
B1630/23
Driver Side Rear Airbag
Sensor Circuit Malfunction
-
ON
RS-75
B1635/24
Front Passenger Side
Rear Airbag Sensor
Circuit Malfunction
-
ON
RS-80
B1650/32
Occupant Classification
System Malfunction
-
ON
RS-85
B1653/35
Seat Position Airbag
Sensor Circuit Malfunction
-
ON
RS-91
B1655/37
Driver Side Seat Belt
Buckle Switch Circuit
Malfunction
-
ON
RS-97
B1660/43
Passenger Airbag ON /
OFF Indicator Circuit
Malfunction
-
ON
RS-103
B1800/51
Short in Driver Side Squib
Circuit
{
ON
RS-112
B1801/51
Open in Driver Side Squib
Circuit
{
ON
RS-112
RS–45
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC No.
Detection Item
Check Mode
SRS Warning Light
See page
B1802/51
Short to GND in Driver
Side Squib Circuit
{
ON
RS-112
B1803/51
Short to B+ in Driver Side
Squib Circuit
{
ON
RS-112
B1805/52
Short in Front Passenger
Side Squib Circuit
{
ON
RS-117
B1806/52
Open in Front Passenger
Side Squib Circuit
{
ON
RS-117
B1807/52
Short to GND in Front
Passenger Side Squib
Circuit
{
ON
RS-117
B1808/52
Short to B+ in Front
Passenger Side Squib
Circuit
{
ON
RS-117
B1810/53
Short in Driver Side Squib
2nd Step Circuit
{
ON
RS-122
B1811/53
Open in Driver Side Squib
2nd Step Circuit
{
ON
RS-122
B1812/53
Short to GND in Driver
Side Squib 2nd Step
Circuit
{
ON
RS-122
B1813/53
Short to B+ in Driver Side
Squib 2nd Step Circuit
{
ON
RS-122
B1815/54
Short in Front Passenger
Side Squib 2nd Step
Circuit
{
ON
RS-127
B1816/54
Open in Front Passenger
Side Squib 2nd Step
Circuit
{
ON
RS-127
B1817/54
Short to GND in Front
Passenger Side Squib 2nd
Step Circuit
{
ON
RS-127
B1818/54
Short to B+ in Front
Passenger Side Squib 2nd
Step Circuit
{
ON
RS-127
B1820/55
Short in Driver Side - Side
Squib Circuit
{
ON
RS-132
B1821/55
Open in Driver Side - Side
Squib Circuit
{
ON
RS-132
B1822/55
Short to GND in Driver
Side - Side Squib Circuit
{
ON
RS-132
B1823/55
Short to B+ in Driver Side Side Squib Circuit
{
ON
RS-132
B1825/56
Short in Front Passenger
Side - Side Squib Circuit
{
ON
RS-137
B1826/56
Open in Front Passenger
Side - Side Squib Circuit
{
ON
RS-137
B1827/56
Short to GND in Front
Passenger Side - Side
Squib Circuit
{
ON
RS-137
B1828/56
Short to B+ in Front
Passenger Side - Side
Squib Circuit
{
ON
RS-137
B1830/57
Short in Driver Side
Curtain Shield Squib
Circuit
{
ON
RS-142
B1831/57
Open in Driver Side
Curtain Shield Squib
Circuit
{
ON
RS-142
RS
RS–46
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC No.
Detection Item
Check Mode
SRS Warning Light
See page
B1832/57
Short to GND in Driver
Side Curtain Shield Squib
Circuit
{
ON
RS-142
B1833/57
Short to B+ in Driver Side
Curtain Shield Squib
Circuit
{
ON
RS-142
B1835/58
Short in Front Passenger
Side Curtain Shield Squib
Circuit
{
ON
RS-146
B1836/58
Open in Front Passenger
Side Curtain Shield Squib
Circuit
{
ON
RS-146
B1837/58
Short to GND in Front
Passenger Side Curtain
Shield Squib Circuit
{
ON
RS-146
B1838/58
Short to B+ in Front
Passenger Side Curtain
Shield Squib Circuit
{
ON
RS-146
B1900/73
Short in Driver Side Front
Pretensioner Squib Circuit
{
ON
RS-150
B1901/73
Open in Driver Side Front
Pretensioner Squib Circuit
{
ON
RS-150
B1902/73
Short to GND in Driver
Side Front Pretensioner
Squib Circuit
{
ON
RS-150
B1903/73
Short to B+ in Driver Side
Front Pretensioner Squib
Circuit
{
ON
RS-150
B1905/74
Short in Front Passenger
Side Front Pretensioner
Squib Circuit
{
ON
RS-154
B1906/74
Open in Front Passenger
Side Front Pretensioner
Squib Circuit
{
ON
RS-154
B1907/74
Short to GND in Front
Passenger Side Front
Pretensioner Squib Circuit
{
ON
RS-154
B1908/74
Short to B+ in Front
Passenger Side Front
Pretensioner Squib Circuit
{
ON
RS-154
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
RS–47
B1000/31 Center Airbag Sensor Assembly Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The center airbag sensor consists of the airbag sensor, the safing sensor, the drive circuit, the diagnosis
circuit and the power control.
When the center airbag sensor receives signals from the airbag sensor, it determines whether or not the
SRS should be activated.
DTC B1000/31 is set when a malfunction is detected in the center airbag sensor.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1000/31
Center airbag sensor malfunction
Center airbag sensor
HINT:
When any other DTCs are set simultaneously with B1000/31, repair the malfunctions indicated by those
DTCs first.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
DLC3
CG
DTC 31
TC
H041086E03
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(e) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-38).
(f) Turn the power switch OFF.
(g) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(h) Check for DTCs (see page RS-38).
OK:
DTC B1000/31 is not output.
NG
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
RS
RS–48
DTC
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
B1610/13 Front Airbag Sensor RH Circuit Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
RS
The front airbag sensor RH consists of the diagnostic circuit and the front deceleration sensor.
If the center airbag sensor receives signals from the frontal deceleration sensor, it determines whether or
not the SRS should be activated.
DTC B1610/13 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the front airbag sensor RH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1610/13
When one of following conditions is met:
• Center airbag sensor receives a line short signal,
an open signal, a short to ground signal or a short
to B+ signal from the front airbag sensor RH sensor
for 2 seconds.
• Front airbag sensor RH malfunction
• Center airbag sensor malfunction
•
•
•
•
Instrument panel wire
Engine room main wire
Front airbag sensor RH
Center airbag sensor
WIRING DIAGRAM
Center Airbag Sensor
Front Airbag Sensor RH
SR+
SR+
SR-
SR-
C123527E01
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–49
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FOR DTC
Front Airbag
Sensor RH
DLC3
Center Airbag
Sensor
DTC 13
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(b) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-38).
(c) Turn the power switch OFF.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(e) Check the DTCs (see page RS-38).
OK:
DTC B1610/13 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1610/13 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
OK
CG
C
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
TC
C130774E02
NG
2
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTOR
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Check that the connectors are properly connected to the
center airbag sensor and the front airbag sensor RH.
OK:
The connectors are properly connected.
NG
OK
CONNECT CONNECTOR
RS
RS–50
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR RH CIRCUIT (OPEN)
RS
E
DC
B
F
A
Front Airbag
Sensor RH
Center Airbag
Sensor
Connector E
Connector B
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
F2-2 (+SR) - F2-1 (-SR)
Below 1 Ω
NG
A18
F2
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the center airbag sensor
and the front airbag sensor RH.
(b) Using a service wire, connect terminals A18-29 (+SR)
and A18-27 (-SR) of connector B.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the
terminals of the connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Go to step 8
10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11
30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21
-SR
+SR
+SR
-SR
Service Wire
C
C130775E02
OK
4
CHECK FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR RH CIRCUIT (SHORT)
(a) Disconnect the service wire from connector B.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
E
DC B
F
A
Front Airbag
Sensor RH
Center Airbag
Sensor
F2
+SR
C
C130776E04
OK
Specified Condition
F2-2 (+SR) - F2-1 (-SR)
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Connector E
-SR
Tester Connection
Go to step 9
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
5
CHECK FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR RH CIRCUIT (TO B+)
E
DC
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
B
F
A
Front Airbag
Sensor RH
Center Airbag
Sensor
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
F2-2 (+SR) - Body ground
Below 1 V
F2-1 (-SR) - Body ground
Below 1 V
NG
Go to step 10
Connector E
F2
-SR
+SR
C
C130776E05
OK
6
CHECK FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR RH CIRCUIT (TO GROUND)
E
DC
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
B
F
A
Front Airbag
Sensor RH
Center Airbag
Sensor
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
F2-2 (+SR) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
F2-1 (-SR) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Connector E
F2
-SR
C
+SR
C130776E01
OK
RS–51
Go to step 11
RS
RS–52
7
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR RH
RS
Front Airbag
Sensor LH
Center Airbag
Sensor
DTC 13
DLC3
DTC 14
CG
C
(a) Connect the connectors to the center airbag sensor.
(b) Interchange the front airbag sensor RH with the front
airbag sensor LH and connect the connectors to them.
(c) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(e) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-38).
(f) Turn the power switch OFF.
(g) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(h) Check the DTCs (see page RS-38).
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC B1610/13 and B1615/14 are not
output.
A
DTC B1610/13 is output.
B
DTC B1615/14 is output.
C
TC
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1610/13 and B1615/14 may be
output at this time, but they are not related to this check.
C130777E01
A
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
B
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
C
REPLACE FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR RH
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
8
RS–53
CHECK ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE (OPEN)
Instrument Panel Wire
E
DC
B
A
F
Front Airbag Engine
Sensor RH Room Main
Wire
Center Airbag
Sensor
Connector D
(a) Disconnect the service wire from connector B.
(b) Disconnect the instrument panel wire connector from the
engine room main wire.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the
terminals of the connector when connecting.
(c) Using a service wire, connect terminals F2-2 (+SR) and
F2-1 (-SR) of connector E.
(d) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
IJ2-1 (+SR) - IJ2-2 (-SR)
Below 1 Ω
Connector E
F2
NG
IJ2
-SR
-SR
+SR
+SR
Service Wire
C123572E01
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
REPAIR OR REPLACE ENGINE ROOM MAIN
WIRE
RS
RS–54
9
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE (SHORT)
(a) Disconnect the engine room main wire connector from
the instrument panel wire.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Instrument Panel Wire
RS
E
D C
B
F
A
Front Airbag Engine
Sensor RH Room Main
Wire
Center Airbag
Sensor
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
IJ2-1 (+SR) - IJ2-2 (-SR)
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Connector D
IJ2
-SR
+SR
C130778E01
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
REPAIR OR REPLACE ENGINE ROOM MAIN
WIRE
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
10
RS–55
CHECK ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE (TO B+)
Instrument Panel Wire
E
D C
B
F
A
Front Airbag Engine
Sensor RH Room Main
Wire
Center Airbag
Sensor
Connector D
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the engine room main wire connector from
the instrument panel wire.
(d) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(e) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(f) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Tester connection
Specified condition
IJ2-1 (+SR) - Body ground
Below 1 V
IJ2-2 (-SR) - Body ground
Below 1 V
IJ2
NG
-SR
+SR
C130778E01
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
REPAIR OR REPLACE ENGINE ROOM MAIN
WIRE
RS
RS–56
11
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE (TO GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the engine room main wire connector from
the instrument panel wire.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Instrument Panel Wire
RS
E
D C
B
F
A
Front Airbag Engine
Sensor RH Room Main
Wire
Center Airbag
Sensor
Tester connection
Specified condition
IJ2-1 (+SR) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
IJ2-2 (-SR) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Connector D
IJ2
-SR
+SR
C130778E01
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
REPAIR OR REPLACE ENGINE ROOM MAIN
WIRE
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
RS–57
B1615/14 Front Airbag Sensor LH Circuit Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The front airbag sensor LH consists of the diagnostic circuit and the front deceleration sensor.
If the center airbag sensor receives signals from the frontal deceleration sensor, it determines whether or
not the SRS should be activated.
DTC B1615/14 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the front airbag sensor LH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1615/14
When one of following conditions is met:
• The center airbag sensor receives a line short
signal, an open signal, a short to ground signal or a
short to B+ signal from the front airbag sensor LH
sensor for 2 seconds.
• Front airbag sensor LH malfunction
• Center airbag sensor malfunction
•
•
•
•
Instrument panel wire
Engine room main wire
Front airbag sensor LH
Center airbag sensor
WIRING DIAGRAM
Front Airbag Sensor LH
Center Airbag Sensor
SL+
SL+
SL-
SL-
C123527E02
RS
RS–58
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FOR DTC
RS
Front Airbag
Sensor LH
DLC3
Center Airbag
Sensor
DTC 14
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(b) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-38).
(c) Turn the power switch OFF.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(e) Check for DTCs (see page RS-38).
OK:
DTC B1615/14 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1615/14 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
OK
CG
C
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
TC
C130779E01
NG
2
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTOR
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Check that the connectors are properly connected to the
center airbag sensor and the front airbag sensor LH.
OK:
The connectors are properly connected.
NG
OK
CONNECT CONNECTOR
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
3
RS–59
CHECK FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR LH CIRCUIT (OPEN)
E
DC
B
A
F
Front Airbag
Sensor LH
Center Airbag
Sensor
Connector E
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the airbag sensor center
and the front airbag sensor LH.
(b) Using a service wire, connect A18-30 (+SL) and A18-28
(-SL) of connector B.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the
terminals of the connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
F1-2 (+SL) - F1-1 (-SL)
Below 1 Ω
Connector B
A18
F1
NG
Go to step 8
10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11
+SL
30 29 28 27 26 25 24 23 22 21
+SL
-SL
-SL
Service Wire
C
C130780E01
OK
4
CHECK FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR LH CIRCUIT (SHORT)
E
DC
(a) Disconnect the service wire from connector B.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
B
F
A
Front Airbag
Sensor LH
Center Airbag
Sensor
Connector E
F1
-SL
C
+SL
C130776E02
OK
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
F1-2 (+SL) - F1-1 (-SL)
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Go to step 9
RS
RS–60
5
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR LH CIRCUIT (TO B+)
RS
E
DC
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
B
F
A
Front Airbag
Sensor LH
Center Airbag
Sensor
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
F1-2 (+SL) - Body ground
Below 1 V
F1-1 (-SL) - Body ground
Below 1 V
NG
Go to step 10
Connector E
F1
-SL
+SL
C
C130776E02
OK
6
CHECK FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR LH CIRCUIT (TO GROUND)
E
DC
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
B
F
A
Front Airbag
Sensor LH
Center Airbag
Sensor
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
F1-2 (+SL) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
F1-1 (-SL) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Connector E
F1
-SL
C
+SL
C130776E02
OK
Go to step 11
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
7
RS–61
CHECK FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR LH
Front Airbag
Sensor RH
Center Airbag
Sensor
DTC 13
DLC3
DTC 14
CG
C
(a) Connect the connectors to the center airbag sensor.
(b) Interchange the front airbag sensor LH with the front
airbag sensor RH and connect the connectors to them.
(c) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(e) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-38).
(f) Turn the power switch OFF.
(g) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(h) Check for DTCs (see page RS-38).
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC B1610/13 and B1615/14 are not
output.
A
DTC B1615/14 is output.
B
DTC B1610/13 is output.
C
TC
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1610/13 and B1615/14 may be
output at this time, but they are not related to this check.
C130777E02
A
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
B
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
C
REPLACE FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR LH
RS
RS–62
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
8
CHECK ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE (OPEN)
Instrument Panel Wire
RS
E
D C
B
A
F
Front Airbag Engine
Sensor LH Room Main
Wire
Center Airbag
Sensor
Connector D
Connector E
IJ2
+SL
-SL
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
IJ2-3 (+SL) - IJ2-4(-SL)
Below 1 Ω
NG
F1
-SL
(a) Disconnect the service wire from connector B.
(b) Disconnect the instrument panel wire connector from the
engine room main wire.
(c) Using a service wire, connect terminals F1-2 (+SL) and
F1-1 (-SL) of connector E.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the
terminals of the connector.
(d) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
+SL
C130781E01
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
REPAIR OR REPLACE ENGINE ROOM MAIN
WIRE
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
9
RS–63
CHECK ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE (SHORT)
(a) Disconnect the engine room main wire connector from
the instrument panel wire.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Instrument Panel Wire
E
D C
B
A
F
Front Airbag Engine
Sensor LH Room Main
Wire
Center Airbag
Sensor
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
IJ2-3 (+SL) - IJ2-4 (-SL)
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Connector D
IJ2
-SL
+SL
C130782E01
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
REPAIR OR REPLACE ENGINE ROOM MAIN
WIRE
RS
RS–64
10
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE (TO B+)
Instrument Panel Wire
RS
E
D C
B
A
F
Front Airbag Engine
Sensor LH Room Main
Wire
Center Airbag
Sensor
Connector D
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the engine room main wire connector from
the instrument panel wire.
(d) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(e) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(f) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
IJ2-3 (+SL) - Body ground
Below 1 V
IJ2-4 (-SL) - Body ground
Below 1 V
IJ2
NG
-SL
+SL
C130782E01
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
REPAIR OR REPLACE ENGINE ROOM MAIN
WIRE
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
11
RS–65
CHECK ENGINE ROOM MAIN WIRE (TO GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the engine room main wire connector from
the instrument panel wire.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Instrument Panel Wire
E
D C
B
A
F
Front Airbag Engine
Sensor LH Room Main
Wire
Center Airbag
Sensor
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
IJ2-3 (+SL) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
IJ2-4 (-SL) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Connector D
IJ2
-SL
+SL
C130782E01
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
REPAIR OR REPLACE ENGINE ROOM MAIN
WIRE
RS
RS–66
DTC
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
B1620/21
Driver Side - Side Airbag Sensor Circuit Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
RS
The side airbag sensor LH consists of the safing sensor, the diagnostic circuit and the lateral deceleration
sensor. The center airbag sensor receives signals from the lateral deceleration sensor and determines
whether or not the SRS should be activated.
DTC B1620/21 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the side airbag sensor LH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1620/21
When one of following conditions is met:
• Center airbag sensor receives line short
signal, open signal, short to ground or B+
short signal from side airbag sensor LH
sensor for 2 seconds
• Side airbag sensor LH malfunction
• Center airbag sensor malfunction
•
•
•
Floor wire
Center airbag sensor
Side airbag sensor LH
WIRING DIAGRAM
Side Airbag Sensor LH
VUPL
ESL
Center Airbag Sensor
VUPD
ESD
C123527E06
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–67
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FOR DTC
Side Airbag
Sensor LH
DLC3
CG
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(b) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-38).
(c) Turn the power switch OFF.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(e) Check for DTCs (see page RS-38).
OK:
DTC B1620/21 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1620/21 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
Center Airbag
Sensor
OK
DTC 21
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
TC
C130783E01
NG
2
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTOR
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Check that the connectors are properly connected to the
center airbag sensor and side airbag sensor LH.
OK:
Connectors are connected.
NG
OK
CONNECT CONNECTOR
RS
RS–68
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (OPEN)
C
RS
B
A
D
Side Airbag
Sensor LH
Center Airbag
Sensor
Floor Wire
Connector C
Connector B
S18
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the center airbag sensor
and side airbag sensor LH.
(b) Using a service wire, connect terminals S18-2 (VUPL)
and S18-1 (ESL) of connector C.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the
terminals of the connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A17-19 (VUPD) - A17-21 (ESD)
Below 1 Ω
A17
NG
ESL
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
VUPL
VUPD
ESD
C130784E01
OK
4
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (SHORT)
C
(a) Disconnect the service wire from connector C.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
B
A
D
Side Airbag
Sensor LH
Center Airbag
Sensor
Floor Wire
Connector B
A17
ESD
VUPD
C123576E02
OK
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A17-19 (VUPD) - A17-21 (ESD)
1 MΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
5
RS–69
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (TO B+)
C
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
B
A
D
Side Airbag
Sensor LH
Tester Connection
Center Airbag
Sensor
Floor Wire
Specified Condition
A17-19 (VUPD) - Body ground
Below 1 V
A17-21 (ESD) - Body ground
Below 1 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
Connector B
A17
ESD
VUPD
C123576E02
OK
6
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (TO GROUND)
C
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
B
A
D
Side Airbag
Sensor LH
Center Airbag
Sensor
Floor Wire
A17
VUPD
C123576E02
OK
Specified Condition
A17-19 (VUPD) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
A17-21 (ESD) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Connector B
ESD
Tester Connection
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
RS
RS–70
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
7
CHECK SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR LH
(a) Connect the connector to the center airbag sensor.
(b) Interchange the side airbag sensor LH with the side
airbag sensor RH and connect the connectors to them.
(c) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(e) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-38).
(f) Turn the power switch OFF.
(g) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(h) Check for DTCs (see page RS-38).
Result
RS
Side Airbag
Sensor RH
Center Airbag
Sensor
DTC 21
DLC3
DTC 22
CG
TC
Result
Proceed to
DTC B1620/21 and B1625/22 are not
output
A
DTC B1620/21 is output
B
DTC B1625/22 is output
C
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1620/21 and B1625/22 may be
output at this time, but they are not related to this check.
C123577E02
A
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
B
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
C
REPLACE SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR LH
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
B1625/22
RS–71
Front Passenger Side - Side Airbag Sensor Circuit Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The side airbag sensor RH consists of the safing sensor, the diagnostic circuit and the lateral deceleration
sensor. The center airbag sensor receives signals from the lateral deceleration sensor and determines
whether or not the SRS should be activated.
DTC B1625/22 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the side airbag sensor RH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1625/22
When one of following conditions is met:
• Center airbag sensor receives line short
signal, open signal, short to ground or B+
short signal from side airbag sensor RH
sensor for 2 seconds
• Side airbag sensor RH malfunction
• Center airbag sensor malfunction
•
•
•
No. 2 floor wire
Center airbag sensor
Side airbag sensor RH
WIRING DIAGRAM
Side Airbag Sensor RH
Center Airbag Sensor
VUPR
VUPP
ESR
ESP
C123527E07
RS
RS–72
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(b) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-38).
(c) Turn the power switch OFF.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(e) Check for DTCs (see page RS-38).
OK:
DTC B1622/25 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1622/25 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
RS
Side Airbag
Sensor RH
Center Airbag
Sensor
OK
DLC3
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
DTC 22
CG TC
C130785E01
NG
2
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTOR
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Check that the connectors are properly connected to the
center airbag sensor and side airbag sensor RH.
OK:
Connectors are connected.
NG
OK
CONNECT CONNECTOR
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
3
RS–73
CHECK NO. 2 FLOOR WIRE (OPEN)
C
B
A
D
Center Airbag
Sensor
Side Airbag
Sensor RH
No. 2 Floor Wire
Connector C
Connector B
ESR
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A19-22 (VUPP) - A19-20 (ESP)
Below 1 Ω
NG
A19
S19
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the center airbag sensor
and side airbag sensor RH.
(b) Using a service wire, connect terminals S19-2 (VUPR)
and S19-1 (ESR) of connector C.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the
terminals of the connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
REPAIR OR REPLACE NO. 2 FLOOR WIRE
VUPR
ESP
VUPP
C130786E01
OK
4
CHECK NO. 2 FLOOR WIRE (SHORT)
(a) Disconnect the service wire from connector C.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
No. 2 Floor Wire
C
B
A
D
Side Airbag
Sensor RH
Center Airbag
Sensor
Connector B
A19
VUPP
ESP
C123579E02
OK
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A19-22 (VUPP) - A19-20 (ESP)
1 MΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE NO. 2 FLOOR WIRE
RS
RS–74
5
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK NO. 2 FLOOR WIRE (TO B+)
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
No. 2 Floor Wire
C
B
A
D
Center Airbag
Sensor
Side Airbag
Sensor RH
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A19-22 (VUPP) - Body ground
Below 1 V
A19-20 (ESP) - Body ground
Below 1 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE NO. 2 FLOOR WIRE
Connector B
A19
ESP
VUPP
C123579E02
OK
6
CHECK NO. 2 FLOOR WIRE (TO GROUND)
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
No. 2 Floor Wire
C
B
A
D
Side Airbag
Sensor RH
Center Airbag
Sensor
A19
ESP
C123579E02
OK
Specified Condition
A19-22 (VUPP) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
A19-20 (ESP) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Connector B
VUPP
Tester Connection
REPAIR OR REPLACE NO. 2 FLOOR WIRE
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
7
RS–75
CHECK SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR RH
Side Airbag
Sensor LH
Center Airbag
Sensor
DTC 21
DLC3
DTC 22
CG
TC
(a) Connect the connector to the center airbag sensor.
(b) Interchange the side airbag sensor RH with the side
airbag sensor LH and connect the connectors to them.
(c) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(e) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-38).
(f) Turn the power switch OFF.
(g) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(h) Check for DTCs (see page RS-38).
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC B1620/21 and B1625/22 are not
output
A
DTC B1625/22 is output
B
DTC B1620/21 is output
C
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1620/21 and B1625/22 may be
output at this time, but they are not related to this check.
H100847E04
A
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
B
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
C
REPLACE SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR RH
RS
RS–76
DTC
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
B1630/23
Driver Side Rear Airbag Sensor Circuit Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
RS
The rear airbag sensor LH consists of the safing sensor, the diagnostic circuit and the lateral deceleration
sensor. The center airbag sensor receives signals from the lateral deceleration sensor and determines
whether or not the SRS should be activated.
DTC B1630/23 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the rear airbag sensor LH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1630/23
When one of following conditions is met:
• Center airbag sensor receives line short
signal, open signal, short to ground or B+
short signal from rear airbag sensor LH
sensor for 2 seconds
• Rear airbag sensor LH malfunction
• Center airbag sensor malfunction
•
•
•
Floor wire
Center airbag sensor
Rear airbag sensor LH
WIRING DIAGRAM
Rear Airbag Sensor LH
Center Airbag Sensor
VUCL
VUCD
ESCL
ESCD
C123527E13
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–77
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(b) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-38).
(c) Turn the power switch OFF.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(e) Check for DTCs (see page RS-38).
OK:
DTC B1630/23 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1630/23 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
Rear Airbag
Sensor LH
Center Airbag
Sensor
OK
DLC3
CG
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
DTC 23
TC
C130787E01
NG
2
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTOR
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Check that the connectors are properly connected to the
center airbag sensor and rear airbag sensor LH.
OK:
Connectors are connected.
NG
OK
CONNECT CONNECTOR
RS
RS–78
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (OPEN)
C
RS
B
A
D
Rear Airbag
Sensor LH
Center Airbag
Sensor
Floor Wire
Connector C
Connector B
C15
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the center airbag sensor
and rear airbag sensor LH.
(b) Using a service wire, connect terminals C15-2 (VUCL)
and C15-1 (ESCL) of connector C.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the
terminals of the connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A17-20 (VUCD) - A17-22 (ESCD)
Below 1 Ω
A17
NG
ESCL
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
VUCL
ESCD
VUCD
C130784E02
OK
4
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (SHORT)
C
(a) Disconnect the service wire from connector C.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
B
A
D
Rear Airbag
Sensor LH
Center Airbag
Sensor
Floor Wire
Connector B
A17
ESCD
VUCD
C123576E03
OK
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A17-20 (VUCD) - A17-22 (ESCD)
1 MΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
5
RS–79
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (TO B+)
C
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
B
A
D
Rear Airbag
Sensor LH
Tester Connection
Center Airbag
Sensor
Floor Wire
Specified Condition
A17-20 (VUCD) - Body ground
Below 1 V
A17-22 (ESCD) - Body ground
Below 1 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
Connector B
A17
ESCD
VUCD
C123576E03
OK
6
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (TO GROUND)
C
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
B
A
D
Rear Airbag
Sensor LH
Center Airbag
Sensor
Floor Wire
A17
VUCD
C123576E03
OK
Specified Condition
A17-20 (VUCD) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
A17-22 (ESCD) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Connector B
ESCD
Tester Connection
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
RS
RS–80
7
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK REAR AIRBAG SENSOR LH
(a) Connect the connector to the center airbag sensor.
(b) Interchange the side airbag sensor LH with the side
airbag sensor RH and connect the connectors to them.
(c) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(e) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-38).
(f) Turn the power switch OFF.
(g) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(h) Check for DTCs (see page RS-38).
Result
RS
Rear Airbag
Sensor RH
Center Airbag
Sensor
DTC 23
DLC3
DTC 24
CG
TC
Result
Proceed to
DTC B1630/23 and B1635/24 are not
output
A
DTC B1630/23 is output
B
DTC B1635/24 is output
C
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1630/23 and B1635/24 may be
output at this time, but they are not related to this check.
C130788E01
A
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
B
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
C
REPLACE REAR AIRBAG SENSOR LH
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
B1635/24
RS–81
Front Passenger Side Rear Airbag Sensor Circuit Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The rear airbag sensor RH consists of the safing sensor, the diagnostic circuit and the lateral deceleration
sensor. The center airbag sensor receives signals from the lateral deceleration sensor and determines
whether or not the SRS should be activated.
DTC B1635/24 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the rear airbag sensor RH circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1635/24
When one of following conditions is met:
• Center airbag sensor receives line short
signal, open signal, short to ground or B+
short signal from side airbag sensor RH
sensor for 2 seconds
• Rear airbag sensor RH malfunction
• Center airbag sensor malfunction
•
•
•
No. 2 Floor wire
Center airbag sensor sensor
Rear airbag sensor RH
WIRING DIAGRAM
Rear Airbag Sensor RH
Center Airbag Sensor
VUCR
VUCP
ESCR
ESCP
C123527E08
RS
RS–82
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(b) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-38).
(c) Turn the power switch OFF.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(e) Check for DTCs (see page RS-38).
OK:
DTC B1635/24 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1635/24 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
RS
Center Airbag
Rear Airbag Sensor
Sensor RH
OK
DLC3
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
DTC 24
CG TC
C130789E01
NG
2
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTOR
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Check that the connectors are properly connected to the
center airbag sensor and rear airbag sensor RH.
OK:
Connectors are connected.
NG
OK
CONNECT CONNECTOR
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
3
RS–83
CHECK NO. 2 FLOOR WIRE (OPEN)
C
B
A
D
Center Airbag
Sensor
Rear Airbag
Sensor RH
No. 2 Floor Wire
Connector C
Connector B
A19
C16
ESCR
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the center airbag sensor
and rear airbag sensor RH.
(b) Using a service wire, connect terminals C16-2 (VUCR)
and C16-1 (ESCR) of connector C.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the
terminals of the connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A19-21 (VUCP) - A19-19 (ESCP)
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE NO. 2 FLOOR WIRE
VUCR
VUCP
ESCP
C130786E02
OK
4
CHECK NO. 2 FLOOR WIRE (SHORT)
(a) Disconnect the service wire from connector C.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
No. 2 Floor Wire
C
B
A
D
Rear Airbag
Sensor RH
Center Airbag
Sensor
Connector B
A19
VUCP
ESCP
C123579E03
OK
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A19-21 (VUCP) - A19-19 (ESCP)
1 MΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE NO. 2 FLOOR WIRE
RS
RS–84
5
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK NO. 2 FLOOR WIRE (TO B+)
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
No. 2 Floor Wire
C
B
Tester Connection
A
D
Center Airbag
Sensor
Rear Airbag
Sensor RH
Specified Condition
A19-21 (VUCP) - Body ground
Below 1 V
A19-19 (ESCP) - Body ground
Below 1 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE NO. 2 FLOOR WIRE
Connector B
A19
ESCP
VUCP
C123579E03
OK
6
CHECK NO. 2 FLOOR WIRE (TO GROUND)
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
No. 2 Floor Wire
C
B
A
D
Rear Airbag
Sensor RH
Center Airbag
Sensor
A19
ESCP
C123579E03
OK
Specified Condition
A19-21 (VUCP) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
A19-19 (ESCP) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Connector B
VUCP
Tester Connection
REPAIR OR REPLACE NO. 2 FLOOR WIRE
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
7
RS–85
CHECK REAR AIRBAG SENSOR RH
Rear Airbag
Sensor LH
(a) Connect the connector to the center airbag sensor.
(b) Interchange the rear airbag sensor RH with the rear
airbag sensor LH and connect the connectors to them.
(c) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(e) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-38).
(f) Turn the power switch OFF.
(g) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(h) Check for DTCs (see page RS-38).
Result
Center Airbag
Sensor
DTC 23
DLC3
DTC 24
CG TC
Result
Proceed to
DTC B1630/23 and B1635/24 are not
output
A
DTC B1635/24 is output
B
DTC B1630/23 is output
C
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1630/23 and B1635/24 may be
output at this time, but they are not related to this check.
C130790E01
A
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
B
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
C
REPLACE REAR AIRBAG SENSOR RH
RS
RS–86
DTC
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
B1650/32 Occupant Classification System Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
RS
The occupant classification system circuit consists of the center airbag sensor and the occupant
classification system.
When the center airbag sensor receives signals from the occupant classification ECU, it determines
whether or not the front passenger airbag, front seat side airbag RH and seat belt pretensioner RH should
be operated.
DTC B1650/32 is set when a malfunction is detected in the occupant classification system circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Conditions
Trouble Areas
B1650/32
When one of following conditions is met:
• Occupant classification system malfunction
• Center airbag sensor detects line short signal, open
signal, short to ground signal or short to B+ signal
from occupant classification system circuit for 2
seconds
• Center airbag sensor malfunction
•
•
•
Floor wire
Occupant classification system
Center airbag sensor
WIRING DIAGRAM
Occupant Classification ECU
Center Airbag Sensor
FSR+
FSP+
FSR-
FSP-
C123527E09
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–87
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK DTC (CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY)
Occupant
Classification
ECU
Center Airbag
Sensor
OK
DTC 32
DLC3
CG
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(b) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-38).
(c) Turn the power switch OFF.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(e) Check for DTCs (see page RS-38).
OK:
DTC B1650/32 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1650/32 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
TC
H100887E06
NG
2
CHECK DTC (OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU)
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 10
seconds.
(b) Using the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM), check for
DTCs of the occupant classification ECU (see page RS182).
OK:
DTC is not output.
NG
GO TO DTC CHART
OK
3
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTOR
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Check that the connectors are properly connected to the
center airbag sensor and the occupant classification
ECU.
OK:
Connectors are connected.
RS
RS–88
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
NG
CONNECT CONNECTOR
OK
RS
4
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (OPEN)
Floor Wire
C
B
A
D
Center Airbag
Sensor
Occupant
Classification
ECU
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the center airbag sensor
and the occupant classification ECU.
(b) Using a service wire, connect terminals O4-8 (FSR+)
and O4-4 (FSR-) of connector C.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the
terminals of the connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Terminal Connection
Specified Condition
A19-16 (FSP+) - A19-24 (FSP-)
Below 1 Ω
Connector B
Connector C
NG
A19
O4
FSR+
FSR- FSP-
FSP+
C130791E01
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
5
RS–89
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (SHORT)
(a) Disconnect the service wire from connector C.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Floor Wire
C
B
A
D
Center Airbag
Sensor
Occupant
Classification
ECU
Terminal Connection
Specified Condition
A19-16 (FSP+) - A19-24 (FSP-)
1 MΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
Connector B
A19
FSP-
FSP+
C130792E01
OK
6
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (TO B+)
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Floor Wire
C
B
A
D
Occupant
Classification
ECU
Center Airbag
Sensor
A19
FSP+
C130792E01
OK
Specified Condition
A19-16 (FSP+) - Body ground
Below 1 V
A19-24 (FSP-) - Body ground
Below 1 V
NG
Connector B
FSP-
Terminal Connection
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
RS
RS–90
7
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (TO GROUND)
RS
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Floor Wire
C
B
A
D
Occupant
Classification
ECU
Center Airbag
Sensor
Terminal Connection
Specified Condition
A19-16 (FSP+) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
A19-24 (FSP-) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
Connector B
A19
FSP-
FSP+
C130792E01
OK
8
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
Occupant
Classification
ECU
Center Airbag
Sensor
DTC 32
DLC3
CG
TC
H100887E07
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Replace the center airbag sensor (see page RS-306).
HINT:
Perform the inspection using parts from a normal vehicle
when possible.
(d) Connect the connectors to the center airbag sensor.
(e) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-38).
(h) Turn the power switch OFF.
(i) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(j) Check for DTCs (see page RS-38).
OK:
DTC B1650/32 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1650/32 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–91
NG
9
REPLACE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Replace the occupant classification ECU (see page SE4).
NEXT
10
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Using the intelligent tester, perform the zero point
calibration (see page RS-174).
OK:
COMPLETED is displayed on the tester.
NEXT
11
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform the sensitivity check
(see page RS-174).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NEXT
END
RS
RS–92
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
B1653/35
Seat Position Airbag Sensor Circuit Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
RS
The seat position airbag sensor circuit consists of the center airbag sensor and the seat position airbag
sensor.
DTC B1653/35 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the seat position airbag sensor circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1653/35
When one of following conditions is met:
• The center airbag sensor receives a line short
signal, an open signal, a short to ground signal or a
short to B+ signal from the seat position airbag
sensor for 2 seconds.
• Seat position airbag sensor malfunction
• Center airbag sensor malfunction
•
•
•
Floor wire
Seat position airbag sensor
Center airbag sensor
WIRING DIAGRAM
Front Seat Inner Belt LH*
Center Airbag Sensor
Seat Position Sensor
DSP+
VS
GND
DSP-
*: A wire harness and connectors that are connected to the seat position
sensor are component parts of the seat inner belt LH.
C123584E05
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–93
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FOR DTC
Seat Position
Airbag Sensor
Center Airbag
Sensor
DLC3
DTC 35
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(b) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-38).
(c) Turn the power switch OFF.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(e) Check the DTCs (see page RS-38).
OK:
DTC B1653/35 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1653/35 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
CG TC
C
C130794E01
NG
2
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTOR
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Check that the connectors are properly connected to the
center airbag sensor and the seat position airbag sensor.
OK:
Connectors are connected.
NG
OK
CONNECT CONNECTOR
RS
RS–94
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (OPEN)
Floor Wire
C
RS
B
D
A
Seat Position
Airbag Sensor
Center Airbag
Sensor
Connector C
Connector B
DSP+
S17
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the center airbag sensor
and the seat position airbag sensor.
(b) Using a service wire, connect terminals A17-9 (DSP+)
and A17-17 (DSP-) of connector B.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the
terminals of the connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S17-2 (VS) - S17-4 (GND)
Below 1 Ω
A17
NG
1 2
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
3 4
GND
VS
DSPC
C130795E01
OK
4
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (SHORT)
(a) Disconnect the service wire from connector B.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Floor Wire
C
B
A
D
Seat Position
Airbag Sensor
Center Airbag
Sensor
Connector C
S17
1 2
VS
3 4
GND
C
C130796E01
OK
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S17-2 (VS) - S17-4 (GND)
1 MΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
5
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (TO B+)
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Floor Wire
C
B
A
D
Seat Position
Airbag Sensor
Tester Connection
Center Airbag
Sensor
Specified Condition
S17-2 (VS) - Body ground
Below 1 V
S17-4 (GND) - Body ground
Below 1 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
Connector C
S17
VS
1 2
3 4
GND
C
C130796E01
OK
6
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (TO GROUND)
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Floor Wire
C
B
A
D
Seat Position
Airbag Sensor
Center Airbag
Sensor
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S17-2 (VS) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
S17-4 (GND) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Connector C
S17
1 2
VS
3 4
GND
C
C130796E01
OK
RS–95
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
RS
RS–96
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
7
CHECK SEAT POSITION AIRBAG SENSOR
RS
Seat Position
Airbag Sensor
Center Airbag
Sensor
DLC3
DTC 35
CG TC
C
C130794E01
(a) Connect the connectors to the center airbag sensor and
the seat position airbag sensor.
(b) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(d) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-38).
(e) Turn the power switch OFF.
(f) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(g) Check the DTCs (see page RS-38).
OK:
DTC B1653/35 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1653/35 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
NG
8
REPLACE SEAT POSITION AIRBAG SENSOR
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Replace the seat position airbag sensor (see page RS319).
HINT:
Perform inspection using parts from a normal vehicle if
possible.
NEXT
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
9
RS–97
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
Seat Position
Airbag Sensor
Center Airbag
Sensor
DLC3
DTC 35
CG TC
C
C130794E01
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(c) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-38).
(d) Turn the power switch OFF.
(e) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(f) Check the DTCs (see page RS-38).
OK:
DTC B1653/35 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1653/35 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
RS
RS–98
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
B1655/37
Driver Side Seat Belt Buckle Switch Circuit Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
RS
The driver side seat belt buckle switch circuit consists of the center airbag sensor and the front seat inner
belt LH.
DTC B1655/37 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the driver side seat belt buckle switch circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1655/37
When one of following conditions is met:
• Center airbag sensor receives a line short signal,
an open signal, a short to ground signal or a short
to B+ signal from the driver side seat belt buckle
switch sensor for 2 seconds.
• Front seat inner belt LH malfunction
• Center airbag sensor malfunction
•
•
•
Floor wire
Front seat inner belt LH (Driver side seat belt
buckle switch)
Center airbag sensor
WIRING DIAGRAM
Front Seat Inner Belt LH*
Center Airbag Sensor
Buckle Switch
DBE+
DBE-
*: A wire harness and connectors that are connected to the seat
position sensor are component parts of the front seat inner belt LH.
C123590E02
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–99
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(b) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-38).
(c) Turn the power switch OFF.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(e) Check the DTCs (see page RS-38).
OK:
DTC B1655/37 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1655/37 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
Front Seat Inner
Belt LH
Center Airbag
Sensor
DLC3
DTC 37
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
CG TC
C
C130797E01
NG
2
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTOR
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Check that the connectors are properly connected to the
center airbag sensor and the front seat inner belt LH.
OK:
Connectors are connected.
NG
OK
CONNECT CONNECTOR
RS
RS–100
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (OPEN)
Floor Wire
RS
C
B
D
A
Front Seat Inner
Belt LH
Center Airbag
Sensor
Connector C
Connector B
S17
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the center airbag sensor
and the front seat inner belt LH.
(b) Using a service wire, connect terminals A17-10 (DBE+)
and A17-18 (DBE-) of connector B.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the
terminals of the connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S17-1 - S17-3
Below 1 Ω
DBE+
A17
NG
1 2
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
3 4
DBE-
C
C130798E01
OK
4
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (SHORT)
(a) Disconnect the service wire from connector B.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Floor Wire
C
B
A
D
Front Seat Inner
Belt LH
Center Airbag
Sensor
Connector C
S17
1 2
3 4
C
C130796E02
OK
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S17-1 - S17-3
1 MΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
5
RS–101
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (TO B+)
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Floor Wire
C
B
A
D
Front Seat Inner
Belt LH
Center Airbag
Sensor
Tester connection
Specified condition
S17-1 - Body ground
Below 1 V
S17-3 - Body ground
Below 1 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
Connector C
S17
1 2
3 4
C
C130796E02
OK
6
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (TO GROUND)
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Floor Wire
C
B
A
D
Front Seat Inner
Belt LH
Center Airbag
Sensor
Tester connection
Specified condition
S17-1 - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
S17-3 - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Connector C
S17
1 2
3 4
C
C130796E02
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
RS
RS–102
7
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY LH
RS
Front Seat Inner
Belt LH
Center Airbag
Sensor
DLC3
DTC 37
CG TC
C
C130797E01
(a) Connect the connectors to the center airbag sensor and
the front seat inner belt LH.
(b) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(d) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-38).
(e) Turn the power switch OFF.
(f) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(g) Check the DTCs (see page RS-38).
OK:
DTC B1655/37 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1655/37 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
NG
8
REPLACE FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Replace the front seat inner belt LH (see page SB-5).
HINT:
Perform inspection using parts from a normal vehicle if
possible.
NEXT
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
9
RS–103
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(c) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-38).
(d) Turn the power switch OFF.
(e) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(f) Check the DTCs (see page RS-38).
OK:
DTC B1655/37 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1655/37 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
Front Seat Inner
Belt LH
Center Airbag
Sensor
DLC3
DTC 37
CG TC
C
C130797E01
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
NG
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
RS
RS–104
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
B1660/43
Passenger Airbag ON / OFF Indicator Circuit
Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
RS
The passenger airbag ON / OFF indicator circuit consists of the center airbag sensor and the front
passenger seat belt warning light.
This circuit indicates the operation condition of the front passenger airbag, front passenger side airbag
and passenger side seat belt pretensioner.
DTC B1660/43 is set when a malfunction is detected in the passenger airbag ON / OFF indicator circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Conditions
Trouble Areas
B1660/43
When one of following is met:
• Center airbag sensor detects line short signal, open
signal, short to ground signal or short to B+ signal
from passenger airbag ON / OFF indicator circuit
for 2 seconds
• Front passenger seat belt warning light malfunction
• Center airbag sensor malfunction
•
•
•
Instrument panel wire
Front passenger airbag ON / OFF Indicator light
Center airbag sensor
WIRING DIAGRAM
Front Passenger Seat
Belt Warning Light
Center Airbag
Sensor
from GAUGE Fuse
IG+
PAON
PAON
to Combination Meter
PBEW
P-AB
P-AB
C130799E01
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–105
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK PASSENGER AIRBAG ON/OFF INDICATOR OPERATION
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Check the passenger airbag ON / OFF indicator
operation.
RS
ON (IG)
Power Switch
OFF
Passenger Airbag
ON / OFF Indicator Light ON
(ON)
OFF
4 sec.
2 sec.
4 sec.
2 sec.
ON
Passenger Airbag
ON / OFF Indicator Light
OFF
(OFF)
ON / OFF condition depends on the
front passenger detection results.
H043700E19
Result
ON / OFF Indicator Illumination
Proceed to
Always ON
A
OFF
B
B
Go to step 8
A
2
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTOR
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Check that the connectors are properly connected to the
center airbag sensor and the front passenger seat belt
warning light.
OK:
Connectors are connected.
NG
OK
CONNECT CONNECTOR
RS–106
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ON/OFF INDICATOR LIGHT
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor.
(b) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Check the passenger airbag ON / OFF indicator
operation.
OK:
Neither ON nor OFF passenger airbag ON / OFF
indicator comes on.
RS
#+4$#) 1(( 10
2#55'0)'4
C130800
OK
Go to step 14
NG
4
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE (OPEN)
Instrument Panel Wire
C
B
A
D
Front Passenger
Seat Belt Warning
Light
Connector C
F11
Center Airbag
Sensor
Connector B
A18
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connector from the front passenger seat
belt warning light.
(d) Using a service wire, connect terminals F11-1 (PAON)
and F11-5 (P-AB) of connector C.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the
terminals of the connector.
(e) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Terminal Connection
Specified Condition
A18-17 (P-AB) - A18-23 (PAON)
Below 1 Ω
PAON
NG
P-AB
PAON
Service Wire
P-AB
C130801E01
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL
WIRE
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
5
RS–107
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE (SHORT)
Instrument Panel Wire
C
B
D
A
Front Passenger
Seat Belt Warning
Light
Center Airbag
Sensor
(a) Disconnect the service wire from connector C.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Terminal Connection
Specified Condition
A18-17 (P-AB) - A18-23 (PAON)
1 MΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL
WIRE
Connector B
A18
P-AB
PAON
C130802E01
OK
6
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE (TO B+)
Instrument Panel Wire
C
B
D
A
Front Passenger
Seat Belt Warning
Light
Center Airbag
Sensor
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Terminal Connection
Specified Condition
A18-23 (PAON) - Body ground
Below 1 V
A18-17 (P-AB) - Body ground
Below 1 V
NG
Connector B
A18
P-AB
PAON
C130802E01
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL
WIRE
RS
RS–108
7
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE (TO GROUND)
Instrument Panel Wire
RS
C
B
D
A
Front Passenger
Seat Belt Warning
Light
Center Airbag
Sensor
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Terminal Connection
Specified Condition
A18-17 (P-AB) -Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
A18-23 (PAON) -Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL
WIRE
Connector B
A18
P-AB
PAON
C130802E01
OK
REPLACE FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ON/OFF INDICATOR LIGHT
8
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTOR
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Check that the connectors are properly connected to the
center airbag sensor and the front passenger seat belt
warning light.
OK:
Connectors are connected.
NG
OK
CONNECT CONNECTOR
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
9
RS–109
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE (OPEN)
Instrument Panel Wire
C
B
A
D
Front Passenger
Seat Belt Warning
Light
Center Airbag
Sensor
Connector C
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor
and the front passenger seat belt warning light.
(b) Using a service wire, connect terminals F11-1 (PAON)
and F11-5 (P-AB) of connector C.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the
terminals of the connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Terminal Connection
Specified Condition
A18-23 (PAON) - A18-17 (P-AB)
Below 1 Ω
Connector B
F11
NG
A18
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL
WIRE
PAON
P-AB
P-AB
PAON
Service Wire
C130801E01
OK
10
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE (SHORT)
Instrument Panel Wire
C
B
D
A
Front Passenger
Seat Belt Warning
Light
Center Airbag
Sensor
Connector B
A18
P-AB
PAON
C130802E01
OK
(a) Disconnect the service wire from connector C.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Terminal Connection
Specified Condition
A18-17 (P-AB) - A18-23 (PAON)
1 MΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL
WIRE
RS
RS–110
11
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE (TO B+)
Instrument Panel Wire
RS
C
B
D
A
Front Passenger
Seat Belt Warning
Light
Center Airbag
Sensor
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Terminal Connection
Specified Condition
A18-23 (PAON) - Body ground
Below 1 V
A18-17 (P-AB) - Body ground
Below 1 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL
WIRE
Connector B
A18
P-AB
PAON
C130802E01
OK
12
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE (TO GROUND)
Instrument Panel Wire
C
B
D
A
Front Passenger
Seat Belt Warning
Light
Center Airbag
Sensor
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Terminal Connection
Specified Condition
A18-17 (P-AB) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
A18-23 (PAON) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Connector B
A18
P-AB
PAON
C130802E01
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL
WIRE
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
13
RS–111
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (POWER SOURCE)
Instrument Panel Wire
C
B
A
D
Front Passenger
Seat Belt
Warning Light
Center Airbag
Sensor
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Terminal Connection
Specified Condition
F11-6 (IG+) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE POWER SOURCE
CIRCUIT
Connector C
F11
IG
C130803E01
OK
14
CHECK FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ON/OFF INDICATOR LIGHT
PAON
F11
P-AB
PBEW
C130804E01
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Using a service wire, connect terminals F11-5 (P-AB)
and F11-4 (PBEW) of the front passenger seat belt
warning light.
(d) Using a service wire, connect terminals F11-1 (PAON)
and F11-4 (PBEW) of the front passenger seat belt
warning light.
(e) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(g) Check the front passenger airbag ON / OFF indicator
operation.
OK:
Front passenger airbag ON / OFF indicator comes
on
NG
OK
REPLACE FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ON/
OFF INDICATOR LIGHT
RS
RS–112
15
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
RS
Front Passenger
Seat Belt Warning
Light
DLC3
Center Airbag
Sensor
DTC 43
CG TC
C130805E01
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the connectors to the center airbag sensor and
the front passenger seat belt warning light.
(d) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(e) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(f) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-38).
(g) Turn the power switch OFF.
(h) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(i) Check for DTCs (see page RS-38).
OK:
DTC B1660/43 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1660/43 may be output at this
time, but they are not related to this check.
NG
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
B1800/51 Short in Driver Side Squib Circuit
DTC
B1801/51 Open in Driver Side Squib Circuit
DTC
B1802/51 Short to GND in Driver Side Squib Circuit
DTC
B1803/51 Short to B+ in Driver Side Squib Circuit
RS–113
DESCRIPTION
The driver side squib circuit consists of the center airbag sensor, the spiral cable and the steering pad.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
These DTCs are recorded when a malfunction is detected in the driver side squib circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1800/51
Center airbag sensor receives a line short signal 5
times from the driver side squib circuit during primary
check.
•
•
•
•
Instrument panel wire
Spiral cable
Steering pad (Driver side squib)
Center airbag sensor
B1801/51
Center airbag sensor receives an open signal from the
driver side squib circuit for 2 seconds.
•
•
•
•
Instrument panel wire
Spiral cable
Steering pad (Driver side squib)
Center airbag sensor
B1802/51
Center airbag sensor receives a short to ground signal
from the driver side squib circuit for 0.5 seconds.
•
•
•
•
Instrument panel wire
Spiral cable
Steering pad (Driver side squib)
Center airbag sensor
B1803/51
Center airbag sensor receives a short to B+ signal from
the driver side squib circuit for 0.5 seconds.
•
•
•
•
Instrument panel wire
Spiral cable
Steering pad (Driver side squib)
Center airbag sensor
RS
RS–114
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
RS
Center Airbag Sensor
Steering Pad
(Driver Side Squib)
D+
D-
D+
D-
Spiral Cable
H101253E04
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "CHECK MODE" (signal check) with the intelligent
tester (see page RS-41).
• After selecting the "CHECK MODE" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on various types of roads (see page RS-41).
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
1
RS–115
CHECK STEERING PAD (DRIVER SIDE SQUIB)
DC
F E
Spiral Cable
Driver Side Squib
Center Airbag
Sensor
Connector E
SST
DLC3
CG
TC
DTC 51
C
C114804E02
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the steering pad.
(d) Connect the white wire side of SST to connector E.
CAUTION:
Never connect SST to the steering pad (driver side
squib) for measurement, as this may lead to a
serious injury due to airbag deployment.
NOTICE:
• Do not forcibly insert SST into the terminals of the
connector when connecting.
• Insert SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-38).
(h) Turn the power switch OFF.
(i) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (see page RS-38).
OK:
DTC B1800, B1801, B1802, B1803 or 51 is not
output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1800, B1801, B1802, B1803 or
51 may be output at this time, but they are not related to
this check.
OK
REPLACE STEERING PAD
NG
2
CHECK CONNECTOR
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect SST from the spiral cable.
(d) Check that the spiral cable connectors (on the steering
pad side) are not damaged.
OK:
Lock button is not disengaged, and claw of lock is
not deformed or damaged.
NG
REPLACE SPIRAL CABLE
RS
RS–116
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
OK
3
RS
CHECK DRIVER SIDE SQUIB CIRCUIT
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the center airbag
sensor.
(b) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Driver Side Squib
A
DC
F E
B
Spiral Cable
Center Airbag
Sensor
D+
Color: Orange
C
Specified Condition
D+ - Body ground
Below 1 V
D- - Body ground
Below 1 V
(e) Turn the power switch OFF.
(f) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(g) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Connector E
D-
Tester Connection
C114805E03
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D+ - D-
Below 1 Ω
D+ - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
D- - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
(h) Release the activation prevention mechanism built into
connector B (see page RS-31).
(i) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D+ - D-
1 MΩ or higher
OK
NG
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
4
RS–117
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
Instrument Panel Wire
A
D C
F E
B
Spiral Cable
Driver Side Squib
Center Airbag
Sensor
Connector C
A22
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A22-1 (D+) - Body ground
Below 1 V
A22-2 (D-) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(f) Turn the power switch OFF.
(g) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(h) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
DD+
C
(a) Restore the released activation prevention mechanism
of connector B to its original position.
(b) Disconnect the instrument panel wire connector from the
spiral cable.
(c) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(e) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
C114807E05
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A22-1 (D+) - A22-2 (D-)
Below 1 Ω
A22-1 (D+) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
A22-2 (D-) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
(i)
(j)
Release the activation prevention mechanism built into
connector B (see page RS-31).
Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A22-1 (D+) - A22-2 (D-)
1 MΩ or higher
NG
OK
REPLACE SPIRAL CABLE
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL
WIRE
RS
RS–118
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
B1805/52 Short in Front Passenger Side Squib Circuit
DTC
B1806/52 Open in Front Passenger Side Squib Circuit
DTC
B1807/52
Short to GND in Front Passenger Side Squib
Circuit
DTC
B1808/52
Short to B+ in Front Passenger Side Squib Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The front passenger side squib circuit consists of the center airbag sensor and the front passenger airbag.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
These DTCs are recorded when a malfunction is detected in the front passenger side squib circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1805/52
Center airbag sensor receives a line short signal 5
times from the front passenger side squib circuit during
primary check.
•
•
•
•
B1806/52
Center airbag sensor receives an open circuit signal
from the front passenger side squib circuit for 2
seconds.
B1807/52
Center airbag sensor receives a short to ground signal
from the front passenger side squib circuit for 0.5
seconds.
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
B1808/52
Center airbag sensor receives a short to B+ signal from
the front passenger side squib circuit for 0.5 seconds.
•
•
•
•
Instrument panel wire
No. 2 instrument panel wire
Front passenger airbag (Front passenger side
squib)
Center airbag sensor
Instrument panel wire
No. 2 instrument panel wire
Front passenger airbag (Front passenger side
squib)
Center airbag sensor
Instrument panel wire
No. 2 instrument panel wire
Front passenger airbag (Front passenger side
squib)
Center airbag sensor
Instrument panel wire
No. 2 instrument panel wire
Front passenger airbag (Front passenger side
squib)
Center airbag sensor
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–119
WIRING DIAGRAM
RS
Center Airbag Sensor
Front Passenger Airbag
(Passenger Side Squib)
P+
P-
P+
P-
H101119E15
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "CHECK MODE" (signal check) with the intelligent
tester (see page RS-41).
• After selecting the "CHECK MODE" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on various types of roads (see page RS-41).
RS–120
1
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY (FRONT PASSENGER SIDE SQUIB)
RS
F E
DC
Front Passenger
Side Squib
Center Airbag
Sensor
Connector E
A20
DLC3
CG
SST
DTC 52
TC
C
C114809E03
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the front passenger
airbag.
(d) Connect the white wire side of SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) to
the instrument panel wire connector E.
CAUTION:
Never connect SST to the front passenger airbag
(front passenger side squib) for measurement, as
this may lead to a serious injury due to airbag
deployment.
NOTICE:
• Do not forcibly insert SST into the terminals of the
connector when connecting.
• Insert SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-38).
(h) Turn the power switch OFF.
(i) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (see page RS-38).
OK:
DTC B1805, B1806, B1807, B1808 or 52 is not
output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1805, B1806, B1807, B1808 or
52 may be output at this time, but they are not related to
this check.
OK
REPLACE FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG
ASSEMBLY
NG
2
CHECK CONNECTOR
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect SST from the instrument panel wire.
(d) Check that the instrument panel wire connectors (on the
front passenger side airbag) are not damaged.
OK:
Lock button is not disengaged, and claw of lock is
not deformed or damaged.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
NG
RS–121
REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
OK
3
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE (FRONT PASSENGER SIDE SQUIB)
Passenger Squib
F E
DC
B A
Center Airbag
Sensor
A20
P+
PColor: Orange
H100374E11
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor.
(b) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A20-1 (P+) - Body ground
Below 1 V
A20-2 (P-) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(e) Turn the power switch OFF.
(f) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(g) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A20-1 (P+) - A20-2 (P-)
Below 1 Ω
A20-1 (P+) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
A20-2 (P-) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
(h) Release the activation prevention mechanism built into
connector B (see page RS-31).
(i) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A20-1 (P+) - A20-2 (P-)
1 MΩ or higher
OK
NG
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
RS
RS–122
4
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK NO. 2 INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
No. 2 Instrument
Panel Wire
Instrument Panel Wire
Center Airbag
Sensor
F E
D C
B A
Passenger
Squib
A20
P+
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A20-1 (P+) - Body ground
Below 1 V
A20-2 (P-) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(d) Turn the power switch OFF.
(e) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(f) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
IH1
P-
P+
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
PC130806E01
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A20-2 (P-) - IH1-2
Below 1 Ω
A20-1 (P+) - IH1-1
Below 1 Ω
A20-2 (P-) - A20-1 (P+)
1 MΩ or higher
A20-2 (P-) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
A20-1 (P+) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
NG
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
REPAIR OR REPLACE NO. 2 INSTRUMENT
PANEL WIRE
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–123
DTC
B1810/53 Short in Driver Side Squib 2nd Step Circuit
DTC
B1811/53 Open in Driver Side Squib 2nd Step Circuit
DTC
B1812/53
Short to GND in Driver Side Squib 2nd Step Circuit
DTC
B1813/53
Short to B+ in Driver Side Squib 2nd Step Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The driver side squib 2nd step circuit consists of the center airbag sensor, the spiral cable and the
steering pad.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
These DTCs are recorded when a malfunction is detected in the driver side squib 2nd step circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1810/53
Center airbag sensor receives a line short signal 5
times from the driver side squib 2nd step circuit during
primary check.
•
•
•
•
Instrument panel wire
Spiral cable
Steering pad (Driver side squib 2nd step)
Center airbag sensor
B1811/53
Center airbag sensor receives an open signal from the
driver side squib 2nd step circuit for 2 seconds.
•
•
•
•
Instrument panel wire
Spiral cable
Steering pad (Driver side squib 2nd step)
Center airbag sensor
B1812/53
Center airbag sensor receives a short circuit to ground
signal from the driver side 2nd step circuit for 0.5
seconds.
•
•
•
•
Instrument panel wire
Spiral cable
Steering pad (Driver side squib 2nd step)
Center airbag sensor
B1813/53
Center airbag sensor receives a short circuit to B+
signal from the driver side squib 2nd step circuit for 0.5
seconds.
•
•
•
•
Instrument panel wire
Spiral cable
Steering pad (Driver side squib 2nd step)
Center airbag sensor
RS
RS–124
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
RS
Center Airbag Sensor
Driver Side Squib 2nd Step
D2+
D2-
D2+
D2-
Spiral Cable
H101118E06
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "CHECK MODE" (signal check) with the intelligent
tester (see page RS-41).
• After selecting the "CHECK MODE" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on various types of roads (see page RS-41).
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
1
RS–125
CHECK STEERING PAD (DRIVER SIDE SQUIB 2ND STEP)
F E
DC
Spiral Cable
Driver Side
Squib 2nd Step
Center Airbag
Sensor
Connector E
SST
DLC3
CG
DTC 53
TC
C
C114814E02
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the steering pad.
(d) Connect the white wire side of SST to the spiral cable
connector E.
CAUTION:
Never connect SST to the steering pad (driver side
squib 2nd step) for measurement, as this may lead
to a serious injury due to airbag deployment.
NOTICE:
• Do not forcibly insert SST into the terminals of the
connector when connecting.
• Insert SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-38).
(h) Turn the power switch OFF.
(i) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (see page RS-38).
OK:
DTC B1810, B1811, B1812, B1813 or 53 is not
output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1810, B1811, B1812, B1813 or
53 may be output at this time, but they are not related to
this check.
OK
REPLACE STEERING PAD
NG
2
CHECK CONNECTOR
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect SST from the spiral cable.
(d) Check that the spiral cable connector (on the steering
pad side) is not damaged.
OK:
Lock button is not disengaged, and claw of lock is
not deformed or damaged.
NG
REPLACE SPIRAL CABLE
RS
RS–126
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
OK
3
RS
CHECK DRIVER SIDE SQUIB 2ND STEP CIRCUIT
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor.
(b) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Driver Side Squib 2nd Step
A
F E
DC
Spiral Cable
B
Center Airbag
Sensor
Connector E
D2-
C
D2+
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D2+ - Body ground
Below 1 V
D2- - Body ground
Below 1 V
(e) Turn the power switch OFF.
(f) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(g) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D2+ - D2-
Below 1 Ω
D2+ - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
D2- - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
C114815E02
(h) Release the activation prevention mechanism built into
connector B (see page RS-31).
(i) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D2+ - D2-
1 MΩ or higher
OK
OK
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
4
RS–127
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
Instrument Panel Wire
A
D C
F E
B
Spiral Cable
Driver Side Squib
2nd Step
Center Airbag
Sensor
Connector C
A22
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A22-4 (D2+) - Body ground
Below 1 V
A22-3 (D2-) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(f) Turn the power switch OFF.
(g) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(h) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
D2-
D2+
C
(a) Restore the released activation prevention mechanism
of connector B to its original position.
(b) Disconnect the instrument panel wire connector from the
spiral cable.
(c) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(e) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
C114807E06
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A22-4 (D2+) - A22-3 (D2-)
Below 1 Ω
A22-4 (D2+) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
A22-3 (D2-) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
(i)
(j)
Release the activation prevention mechanism built into
connector B (see page RS-31).
Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A22-4 (D2+) - A22-3 (D2-)
1 MΩ or higher
NG
OK
REPLACE SPIRAL CABLE
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL
WIRE ASSEMBLY
RS
RS–128
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
B1815/54
Short in Front Passenger Side Squib 2nd Step
Circuit
DTC
B1816/54
Open in Front Passenger Side Squib 2nd Step
Circuit
DTC
B1817/54
Short to GND in Front Passenger Side Squib
2nd Step Circuit
DTC
B1818/54
Short to B+ in Front Passenger Side Squib 2nd
Step Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The front passenger side squib 2nd step circuit consists of the center airbag sensor and the front
passenger airbag.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
These DTCs are recorded when a malfunction is detected in the front passenger side squib 2nd step
circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1815/54
Center airbag sensor receives a line short signal 5
times from the front passenger side squib 2nd step
circuit during primary check.
•
•
•
B1816/54
Center airbag sensor receives an open signal from the
front passenger side squib 2nd step circuit for 2
seconds.
•
•
•
•
•
B1817/54
Center airbag sensor receives a short to ground signal
from the front passenger side squib 2nd step circuit for
0.5 seconds.
B1818/54
Center airbag sensor receives a short to B+ signal from
the front passenger side squib 2nd step circuit for 0.5
seconds.
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Instrument panel wire
No. 2 instrument panel wire
Front passenger airbag (Front passenger side
squib 2nd step)
Center airbag sensor
Instrument panel wire
No. 2 instrument panel wire
Front passenger airbag (Front passenger side
squib 2nd step)
Center airbag sensor
Instrument panel wire
No. 2 instrument panel wire
Front passenger airbag (Front passenger side
squib 2nd step)
Center airbag sensor
Instrument panel wire
No. 2 instrument panel wire
Front passenger airbag (Front passenger side
squib 2nd step)
Center airbag sensor
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–129
WIRING DIAGRAM
RS
Center Airbag Sensor
Front Passenger Side Squib 2nd Step
P2+
P2-
P2+
P2-
H101119E05
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "CHECK MODE" (signal check) with the intelligent
tester (see page RS-41).
• After selecting the "CHECK MODE" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on various types of roads (see page RS-41).
RS–130
1
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY (FRONT PASSENGER SIDE SQUIB
2ND STEP)
RS
F E
DC
Front Passenger
Side Squib 2nd Step
Center Airbag
Sensor
Connector E
A21
DLC3
CG
SST
DTC 53
TC
C
C114820E03
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connector to the front passenger airbag.
(d) Connect the white wire side of SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) to
the instrument panel wire connector E.
CAUTION:
Never connect SST to the front passenger airbag
(front passenger side squib 2nd step) for
measurement, as this may lead to a serious injury
due to airbag deployment.
NOTICE:
• Do not forcibly insert SST into the terminals of the
connector when connecting.
• Insert SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-38).
(h) Turn the power switch OFF.
(i) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (see page RS-38).
OK:
DTC B1815, B1816, B1817, B1818 or 54 is not
output.
HINT:
Codes other than DTC B1815, B1816, B1817, B1818
and 54 may be output at this time, but they are not
related to this check.
OK
REPLACE FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG
ASSEMBLY
NG
2
CHECK CONNECTOR
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect SST from the instrument panel wire.
(d) Check that the No. 2 instrument panel wire connector (on
the front passenger side airbag) are not damaged.
OK:
Lock button is not disengaged, and claw of lock is
not deformed or damaged.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
NG
RS–131
REPAIR OR REPLACE NO. 2 INSTRUMENT
PANEL WIRE
OK
3
CHECK INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE (FRONT PASSENGER SIDE SQUIB 2ND STEP)
Passenger Squib 2nd Step
F E
DC
B A
Center Airbag
Sensor
A21
P2+
P2-
H100374E12
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor.
(b) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A21-1 (P2+) - Body ground
Below 1 V
A21-2 (P2-) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(e) Turn the power switch OFF.
(f) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(g) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A21-1 (P2+) - A21-2 (P2-)
Below 1 Ω
A21-1 (P2+) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
A21-2 (P2-) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
(h) Release the activation prevention mechanism built into
connector B (see page RS-31).
(i) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A21-1 (P2+) - A21-2 (P2-)
1 MΩ or higher
OK
NG
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
RS
RS–132
4
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK NO. 2 INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
No. 2 Instrument
Panel Wire
Instrument Panel Wire
Center Airbag
Sensor
F E
D C
B A
Passenger
Squib 2nd
Step
A21
P2+
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A21-1 (P2+) - Body ground
Below 1 V
A21-2 (P2-) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(d) Turn the power switch OFF.
(e) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(f) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
IH1
P2-
P2+
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
P2C130806E02
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A21-1 (P2+) - IH1-3
Below 1 Ω
A21-2 (P2-) - IH1-4
Below 1 Ω
A21-1 (P2+) - A21-2 (P2-)
Below 1 Ω
A21-1 (P2+) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
A21-2 (P2-) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
NG
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
REPAIR OR REPLACE NO. 2 INSTRUMENT
PANEL WIRE
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–133
DTC
B1820/55 Short in Driver Side - Side Squib Circuit
DTC
B1821/55 Open in Driver Side - Side Squib Circuit
DTC
B1822/55 Short to GND in Driver Side - Side Squib Circuit
DTC
B1823/55 Short to B+ in Driver Side - Side Squib Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The driver side - side squib circuit consists of the center airbag sensor and the front seat side airbag LH.
This circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
These DTCs are recorded when a malfunction is detected in the driver side - side squib circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1820/55
Center airbag sensor receives a line short signal 5
times from the driver side - side squib circuit during
primary check.
•
•
•
•
Floor wire
No. 1 seat airbag wire
Front seat side airbag LH (Driver side - side squib)
Center airbag sensor
B1821/55
Center airbag sensor receives an open signal from the
driver side - side squib circuit for 2 seconds.
•
•
•
•
Floor wire
No. 1 seat airbag wire
Front seat side airbag LH (Driver side - side squib)
Center airbag sensor
B1822/55
Center airbag sensor receives a short to ground signal
from the driver side - side squib circuit for 0.5 seconds.
•
•
•
•
Floor wire
No. 1 seat airbag wire
Front seat side airbag LH (Driver side - side squib)
Center airbag sensor
B1823/55
Center airbag sensor receives a short to B+ signal from
the driver side - side squib circuit for 0.5 seconds.
•
•
•
•
Floor wire
No. 1 seat airbag wire
Front seat side airbag LH (Driver side - side squib)
Center airbag sensor
RS
RS–134
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
RS
Center Airbag Sensor
Driver Side - Side Squib
SFL+
SFL-
SFD+
SFD-
H101119E38
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "CHECK MODE" (signal check) with the intelligent
tester (see page RS-41).
• After selecting the "CHECK MODE" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on various types of roads (see page RS-41).
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
1
RS–135
CHECK FRONT SEAT SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY LH (DRIVER SIDE - SIDE SQUIB)
F E
DC
Driver Side Side Squib
Center Airbag
Sensor
Connector E
SFL+
SFL-
S20
SST
DLC3
CG
DTC 55
TC
C128712E02
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connector from the front seat side airbag
LH.
(d) Connect the black wire side of SST to connector E.
CAUTION:
Never connect SST to the front seat side airbag LH
(driver side - side squib) for measurement, as this
may lead to a serious injury due to airbag
deployment.
NOTICE:
• Do not forcibly insert SST into the terminals of the
connector when connecting.
• Insert SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-38).
(h) Turn the power switch OFF.
(i) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (see page RS-38).
OK:
DTC B1820, B1821, B1822, B1823 or 55 is not
output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1820, B1821, B1822, B1823 or
55 may be output at this time, but they are not related to
this check.
OK
REPLACE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY LH
NG
2
CHECK CONNECTOR
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect SST from the No. 1 seat airbag wire.
(d) Check that the No. 1 seat airbag wire connector (on the
driver side - side squib) are not damaged.
OK:
Lock button is not disengaged, and claw of lock is
not deformed or damaged.
RS
RS–136
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE NO. 1 SEAT AIRBAG
WIRE
OK
RS
3
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (DRIVER SIDE - SIDE SQUIB CIRCUIT)
F
E
DC
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor.
(b) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
B
A
Tester Condition
Driver Side
- Side Squib
Floor
Wire
Center Airbag
Sensor
S20-1 (SFL-) - Body ground
Below 1 V
S20-2 (SFL+) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(e) Turn the power switch OFF.
(f) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(g) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Connector E
SFL-
Specified Condition
SFL+
S20
Tester Condition
Specified Condition
S20-1 (SFL-) - S20-2 (SFL+)
Below 1 Ω
S20-1 (SFL-) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
S20-2 (SFL+) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
C128713E02
(h) Release the activation prevention mechanism built into
connector B (see page RS-31).
(i) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Tester Condition
Specified Condition
S20-1 (SFL-) - S20-2 (SFL+)
1 MΩ or higher
OK
NG
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
4
RS–137
CHECK NO. 1 SEAT AIRBAG WIRE
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Floor Wire
F
E
D C
B
A
Driver Side
- Side Squib
No. 1 Seat
Airbag Wire
Tester Connection
Center Airbag
Sensor
Connector E
S20
SFL-
Connector D
BC1
SFL+
C130807E01
S20-1 (SFL-) - Body ground
Below 1 V
S20-2 (SFL+) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(d) Turn the power switch OFF.
(e) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(f) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S20-2 (SFL+) - BC1-1
Below 1 Ω
S20-1 (SFL-) - BC1-2
Below 1 Ω
S20-2 (SFL+) - S20-1 (SFL-)
1 MΩ or higher
S20-2 (SFL+) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
S20-1 (SFL-) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
NG
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
Specified Condition
REPAIR OR REPLACE NO. 1 SEAT AIRBAG
WIRE
RS
RS–138
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
DTC
B1825/56
Short in Front Passenger Side - Side Squib Circuit
DTC
B1826/56
Open in Front Passenger Side - Side Squib Circuit
DTC
B1827/56
Short to GND in Front Passenger Side - Side
Squib Circuit
DTC
B1828/56
Short to B+ in Front Passenger Side - Side
Squib Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The front passenger side - side squib circuit consists of the center airbag sensor and the front seat side
airbag RH.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
These DTCs are recorded when a malfunction is detected in the front passenger side - side squib circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1825/56
The center airbag sensor receives a line short signal 5
times from the front passenger side - side squib circuit
during primary check.
•
•
•
•
B1826/56
Center airbag sensor receives an open signal from the
front passenger side - side squib circuit for 2 seconds.
B1827/56
Center airbag sensor receives a short to ground signal
from the front passenger side - side squib circuit for 0.5
seconds.
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
B1828/56
Center airbag sensor receives a short to B+ signal from
the front passenger side - side squib circuit for 0.5
seconds.
•
•
•
•
No. 2 floor wire
No. 2 seat airbag wire
Front seat side airbag RH (Front passenger side side squib)
Center airbag sensor
No. 2 floor wire
No. 2 seat airbag wire
Front seat side airbag RH (Front passenger side side squib)
Center airbag sensor
No. 2 floor wire
No. 2 seat airbag wire
Front seat side airbag RH (Front passenger side side squib)
Center airbag sensor
No. 2 floor wire
No. 2 seat airbag wire
Front seat side airbag RH (Front passenger side side squib)
Center airbag sensor
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–139
WIRING DIAGRAM
RS
Center Airbag Sensor
Front Passenger Side - Side Squib
SFR+
SFP+
SFR-
SFP-
H101119E16
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "CHECK MODE" (signal check) with the intelligent
tester (see page RS-41).
• After selecting the "CHECK MODE" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on various types of roads (see page RS-41).
RS–140
1
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT SEAT SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY RH (FRONT PASSENGER SIDE - SIDE
SQUIB)
RS
F E
DC
Front Passenger
Side - Side Squib
Center Airbag
Sensor
Connector E
SFR-
SFR+
S21
SST
DLC3
CG
DTC 56
TC
C128717E02
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connector from the front seat side airbag
RH.
(d) Connect the black wire side of SST to connector E.
CAUTION:
Never connect SST to the front seat side airbag RH
(front passenger side - side squib) for measurement,
as this may lead to a serious injury due to airbag
deployment.
NOTICE:
• Do not forcibly insert SST into the terminals of the
connector when connecting.
• Insert SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-38).
(h) Turn the power switch OFF.
(i) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (see page RS-38).
OK:
DTC B1825, B1826, B1827, B1828 or 56 is not
output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1825, B1826, B1827, B1828 or
56 may be output at this time, but they are not related to
this check.
OK
REPLACE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY RH
NG
2
CHECK CONNECTOR
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the SST from connector E.
(d) Check that the No. 2 seat airbag wire connector (on the
front passenger side - side squib) are not damaged.
OK:
Lock button is not disengaged, and claw of lock is
not deformed or damaged.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
NG
RS–141
REPAIR OR REPLACE NO. 2 SEAT AIRBAG
WIRE
OK
3
CHECK NO. 2 FLOOR WIRE (FRONT PASSENGER SIDE - SIDE SQUIB CIRCUIT)
F
E
DC
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor.
(b) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
B
A
Front Passenger
Side - Side Squib
Tester Connection
Center Airbag
Sensor
S21-1 (SFR-) - Body ground
Below 1 V
S21-2 (SFR+) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(e) Turn the power switch OFF.
(f) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(g) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Connector E
SFR-
Specified Condition
SFR+
S21
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S21-1 (SFR-) - S21-2 (SFR+)
Below 1 Ω
S21-1 (SFR-) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
S21-2 (SFR+) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
C128718E02
(h) Release the activation prevention mechanism built into
connector B (see page RS-31).
(i) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Tester connection
Specified condition
S21-1 (SFR-) - S21-2 (SFR+)
1 MΩ or higher
OK
NG
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
RS
RS–142
4
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK NO. 2 SEAT AIRBAG WIRE
No. 2 Floor Wire
No. 2 Seat
Airbag Wire
F
E
D C
B
A
Center Airbag
Sensor
Front Passenger
Side - Side Squib
Connector E
S21
SFR-
Connector D
BG1
SFR+
C130808E01
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Turn the power switch OFF.
(c) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S21-1 (SFR-) - Body ground
Below 1 V
S21-2 (SFR+) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(d) Turn the power switch OFF.
(e) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(f) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S21-1 (SFR-) - BG1-2
Below 1 Ω
S21-2 (SFR+) - BG1-1
Below 1 Ω
S21-1 (SFR-) - S21-2 (SFR+)
1 MΩ or higher
S21-1 (SFR-) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
S21-2 (SFR+) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
NG
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE NO. 2 FLOOR WIRE
REPAIR OR REPLACE NO. 2 SEAT AIRBAG
WIRE
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–143
DTC
B1830/57
Short in Driver Side Curtain Shield Squib Circuit
DTC
B1831/57
Open in Driver Side Curtain Shield Squib Circuit
DTC
B1832/57
Short to GND in Driver Side Curtain Shield
Squib Circuit
DTC
B1833/57
Short to B+ in Driver Side Curtain Shield Squib
Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The driver side curtain shield squib circuit consists of the center airbag sensor and the curtain shield
airbag LH.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
These DTCs are recorded when a malfunction is detected in the driver side curtain shield squib circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1830/57
Center airbag sensor receives a line short signal 5
times from the driver side curtain shield squib circuit
during primary check.
•
•
B1831/57
Center airbag sensor receives an open signal from the
driver side curtain shield squib circuit for 2 seconds.
•
•
B1832/57
Center airbag sensor receives a short to ground signal
from the driver side curtain shield squib circuit for 0.5
seconds.
•
•
B1833/57
Center airbag sensor receives a short to B+ signal from
the driver side curtain shield squib circuit for 0.5
seconds.
•
•
•
•
•
•
Floor wire
Curtain shield airbag LH (Driver side curtain shield
squib)
Center airbag sensor
Floor wire
Curtain shield airbag LH (Driver side curtain shield
squib)
Center airbag sensor
Floor wire
Curtain shield airbag LH (Driver side curtain shield
squib)
Center airbag sensor
Floor wire
Curtain shield airbag LH (Driver side curtain shield
squib)
Center airbag sensor
RS
RS–144
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
RS
Center Airbag Sensor
Driver Side Curtain Shield Squib
IGL+
IGL-
ICD+
ICD-
H101119E17
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "CHECK MODE" (signal check) with the intelligent
tester (see page RS-41).
• After selecting the "CHECK MODE" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on various types of roads (see page RS-41).
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
1
CHECK CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY LH (DRIVER SIDE CURTAIN SHIELD
SQUIB)
D C
Driver Side Curtain
Shield Squib
Center Airbag
Sensor
Connector C
C17
SST
DLC3
CG
RS–145
DTC 57
TC
C130809E01
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connector from the curtain shield airbag
LH.
(d) Connect the white wire side of SST to connector C.
CAUTION:
Never connect SST to the curtain shield airbag LH
(driver side curtain shield squib) for measurement,
as this may lead to a serious injury due to airbag
deployment.
NOTICE:
• Do not forcibly insert SST into the terminals of the
connector when connecting.
• Insert SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-38).
(h) Turn the power switch OFF.
(i) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (see page RS-38).
OK:
DTC B1830, B1831, B1832, B1833 or 57 is not
output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1830, B1831, B1832, B1833 or
57 may be output at this time, but they are not related to
this check.
OK
REPLACE CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG
ASSEMBLY LH
NG
2
CHECK CONNECTOR
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the SST from connector C.
(d) Check that the floor wire connector (on the curtain shield
LH side) is not damaged.
OK:
Lock button is not disengaged, and claw of lock is
not deformed or damaged.
RS
RS–146
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
OK
RS
3
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (DRIVER SIDE CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB CIRCUIT)
D C
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor.
(b) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
B
A
Floor
Wire
Center Airbag
Sensor
Driver Side
Curtain Shield
Squib
Specified Condition
C17-1 (IGL+) - Body ground
Below 1 V
C17-2 (IGL-) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(e) Turn the power switch OFF.
(f) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(g) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Connector C
C17
IGL+
Tester Connection
IGL-
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
C17-1 (IGL+) - C17-2 (IGL-)
Below 1 Ω
C17-1 (IGL+) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
C17-2 (IGL-) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
C130810E01
(h) Release the activation prevention mechanism built into
connector B (see page RS-31).
(i) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
C17-1 (IGL+) - C17-2 (IGL-)
1 MΩ or higher
NG
OK
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–147
DTC
B1835/58
Short in Front Passenger Side Curtain Shield
Squib Circuit
DTC
B1836/58
Open in Front Passenger Side Curtain Shield
Squib Circuit
DTC
B1837/58
Short to GND in Front Passenger Side Curtain
Shield Squib Circuit
DTC
B1838/58
Short to B+ in Front Passenger Side Curtain
Shield Squib Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The front passenger side curtain shield squib circuit consists of the center airbag sensor and the curtain
shield airbag RH.
The circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
These DTCs are recorded when a malfunction is detected in the front passenger side curtain shield squib
circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1835/58
Center airbag sensor receives a line short circuit signal
5 times from the front passenger side curtain shield
squib circuit during primary check.
•
•
•
B1836/58
Center airbag sensor receives an open signal from the
front passenger side curtain shield squib circuit for 2
seconds.
•
•
•
B1837/58
Center airbag sensor receives a short to ground signal
from the front passenger side curtain shield squib circuit
for 0.5 seconds.
•
•
•
B1838/58
Center airbag sensor receives a short to B+ signal from
the front passenger side curtain shield squib circuit for
0.5 seconds.
•
•
•
No. 2 floor wire
Curtain shield airbag RH (Front passenger side
curtain shield squib)
Center airbag sensor
No. 2 floor wire
Curtain shield airbag RH (Front passenger side
curtain shield squib)
Center airbag sensor
No. 2 floor wire
Curtain shield airbag RH (Front passenger side
curtain shield squib)
Center airbag sensor
No. 2 floor wire
Curtain shield airbag RH (Front passenger side
curtain shield squib)
Center airbag sensor
RS
RS–148
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
RS
Center Airbag Sensor
Front Passenger Side Curtain Shield Squib
IGR+
IGR-
ICP+
ICP-
H101119E18
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "CHECK MODE" (signal check) with the intelligent
tester (see page RS-41).
• After selecting the "CHECK MODE" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on various types of roads (see page RS-41).
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
1
RS–149
CHECK CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY RH (FRONT PASSENGER SIDE CURTAIN
SHIELD SQUIB)
D C
Front Passenger Side
Curtain Shield Squib
Center Airbag
Sensor
Connector C
C18
SST
DLC3
CG
DTC 58
TC
C
C114827E05
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the curtain shield airbag
RH.
(d) Connect the white wire side of SST (resistance 2.1 Ω) to
connector C.
CAUTION:
Never connect SST to the curtain shield airbag RH
(front passenger side curtain shield squib) for
measurement, as this may lead to a serious injury
due to airbag deployment.
NOTICE:
• Do not forcibly insert SST into the terminals of the
connector when connecting.
• Insert SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-38).
(h) Turn the power switch OFF.
(i) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (see page RS-38).
OK:
DTC B1835, B1836, B1837, B1838 or 58 is not
output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1835, B1836, B1837, B1838 or
58 may be output at this time, but they are not related to
this check.
OK
REPLACE CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG
ASSEMBLY RH
NG
2
CHECK CONNECTOR
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the SST from connector C.
(d) Check that the floor wire connector (on the curtain shield
airbag RH side) are not damaged.
RS
RS–150
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
OK:
Lock button is not disengaged, and claw of lock is
not deformed or damaged.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
OK
RS
3
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (FRONT PASSENGER SIDE CURTAIN SHIELD SQUIB CIRCUIT)
No. 2 Floor
Wire
A
D C
B
Center Airbag
Sensor
Front Passenger Side
Curtain Shield Squib
IGR-
C18
C
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
C18-1 (IGR+) - Body ground
Below 1 V
C18-2 (IGR-) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(e) Turn the power switch OFF.
(f) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(g) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Connector C
IGR+
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the center airbag
sensor.
(b) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
C111666E23
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
C18-1 (IGR+) - C18-2 (IGR-)
Below 1 Ω
C18-1 (IGR+) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
C18-2 (IGR-) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
(h) Release the activation prevention mechanism built into
connector B (see page RS-31).
(i) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
C18-1 (IGR+) - C18-2 (IGR-)
1 MΩ or higher
NG
OK
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–151
DTC
B1900/73
Short in Driver Side Front Pretensioner Squib
Circuit
DTC
B1901/73
Open in Driver Side Front Pretensioner Squib
Circuit
DTC
B1902/73
Short to GND in Driver Side Front Pretensioner
Squib Circuit
DTC
B1903/73
Short to B+ in Driver Side Front Pretensioner
Squib Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The driver side front pretensioner squib circuit consists of the center airbag sensor and the front seat
outer belt LH.
This circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
These DTCs are recorded when a malfunction is detected in the front pretensioner squib circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1900/73
Center airbag sensor receives a line short signal 5
times from the driver side front pretensioner squib
circuit during primary check.
•
•
B1901/73
Center airbag sensor receives an open signal from the
driver side front pretensioner squib circuit for 2
seconds.
•
•
B1902/73
Center airbag sensor receives a short to ground signal
from the driver side front pretensioner squib circuit for
0.5 seconds.
•
•
B1903/73
Center airbag sensor receives a short circuit to B+
signal from the driver side front pretensioner squib
circuit for 0.5 seconds.
•
•
•
•
•
•
Floor wire
Front seat outer belt LH (Driver side front
pretensioner squib)
Center airbag sensor
Floor wire
Front seat outer belt LH (Driver side front
pretensioner squib)
Center airbag sensor
Floor wire
Front seat outer belt LH (Driver side front
pretensioner squib)
Center airbag sensor
Floor wire
Front seat outer belt LH (Driver side front
pretensioner squib)
Center airbag sensor
RS
RS–152
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
RS
Center Airbag Sensor
Driver Side Front Pretensioner Squib
L+
L-
PD+
PD-
H101119E19
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "CHECK MODE" (signal check) with the intelligent
tester (see page RS-41).
• After selecting the "CHECK MODE" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on various types of roads (see page RS-41).
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
1
RS–153
CHECK FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY LH (DRIVER SIDE FRONT
PRETENSIONER SQUIB)
D C
Driver Side Front
Pretensioner Squib
Center Airbag
Sensor
Connector C
P22
SST
DLC3
DTC 73
CG TC
C130811E01
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the front seat outer belt
LH.
(d) Connect the white wire side of SST to connector C.
CAUTION:
Never connect SST to the front seat outer belt LH
(driver side front pretensioner squib) for
measurement, as this may lead to a serious injury
due to airbag deployment.
NOTICE:
• Do not forcibly insert SST into the terminals of the
connector when connecting.
• Insert SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-38).
(h) Turn the power switch OFF.
(i) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (see page RS-38).
OK:
DTC B1900, B1901, B1902, B1903 or 73 is not
output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1900, B1901, B1902, B1903 or
73 may be output at this time, but they are not related to
this check.
OK
REPLACE FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT
ASSEMBLY LH
NG
2
CHECK CONNECTOR
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the SST from connector C.
(d) Check that the floor wire connector (on the driver side
front seat outer belt) is not damaged.
OK:
The lock button is not disengaged, or the claw of
the lock is not deformed or damaged.
RS
RS–154
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
OK
RS
3
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (DRIVER SIDE FRONT PRETENSIONER SQUIB CIRCUIT)
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor.
(b) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Floor Wire
D C
B
A
Driver Side Front
Pretensioner Squib
Center Airbag
Sensor
Specified Condition
P22-1 (L+) - Body ground
Below 1 V
P22-2 (L-) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(e) Turn the power switch OFF.
(f) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(g) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Connector C
P22
L+
Tester Connection
L-
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
P22-1 (L+) - P22-2 (L-)
Below 1 Ω
P22-1 (L+) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
P22-2 (L-) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
C130812E01
(h) Release the activation prevention mechanism built into
connector B (see page RS-31).
(i) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
P22-1 (L+) - P22-2 (L-)
1 MΩ or higher
NG
OK
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–155
DTC
B1905/74
Short in Front Passenger Side Front Pretensioner Squib Circuit
DTC
B1906/74
Open in Front Passenger Side Front Pretensioner Squib Circuit
DTC
B1907/74
Short to GND in Front Passenger Side Front
Pretensioner Squib Circuit
DTC
B1908/74
Short to B+ in Front Passenger Side Front Pretensioner Squib Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The front passenger side front pretensioner squib circuit consists of the center airbag sensor and the front
seat outer belt RH.
This circuit instructs the SRS to deploy when deployment conditions are met.
These DTCs are recorded when a malfunction is detected in the front passenger side front pretensioner
squib circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B1905/74
Center airbag sensor receives a line short signal 5
times from the front passenger side front pretensioner
squib circuit during primary check.
•
•
•
B1906/74
Center airbag sensor receives an open signal from the
front passenger side front pretensioner squib circuit for
2 seconds.
•
•
•
B1907/74
Center airbag sensor receives a short to ground signal
from the front passenger side front pretensioner squib
circuit for 0.5 seconds.
•
•
•
B1908/74
Center airbag sensor receives a short to B+ signal from
the front passenger side front pretensioner squib circuit
for 0.5 seconds.
•
•
•
No. 2 floor wire
Front seat outer belt RH (Front passenger side
front pretensioner squib)
Center airbag sensor
No. 2 floor wire
Front seat outer belt RH (Front passenger side
front pretensioner squib)
Center airbag sensor
No. 2 floor wire
Front seat outer belt RH (Front passenger side
front pretensioner squib)
Center airbag sensor
No. 2 floor wire
Front seat outer belt RH (Front passenger side
front pretensioner squib)
Center airbag sensor
RS
RS–156
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
RS
Center Airbag Sensor
Front Passenger Side
Front Pretensioner Squib
R+
R-
PP+
PP-
H101119E20
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• Perform the simulation method by selecting the "CHECK MODE" (signal check) with the intelligent
tester (see page RS-41).
• After selecting the "CHECK MODE" (signal check), perform the simulation method by wiggling each
connector of the airbag system or driving the vehicle on various types of roads (see page RS-41).
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
1
CHECK FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY RH (FRONT PASSENGER SIDE FRONT
PRETENSIONER SQUIB)
D C
Front Passenger Side
Front Pretensioner Squib
Center Airbag
Sensor
Connector C
P23
DLC3
CG
RS–157
SST
DTC 74
TC
C
C109514E13
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the front seat outer belt
RH.
(d) Connect the white wire side of SST to connector C.
CAUTION:
Never connect SST to the front seat outer belt RH
(front passenger side front pretensioner squib) for
measurement, as this may lead to a serious injury
due to airbag deployment.
NOTICE:
• Do not forcibly insert SST into the terminals of the
connector when connecting.
• Insert SST straight into the terminals of the
connector.
SST 09843-18060
(e) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(f) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(g) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-38).
(h) Turn the power switch OFF.
(i) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(j) Check the DTCs (see page RS-38).
OK:
DTC B1905, B1906, B1907, B1908 or 74 is not
output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1905, B1906, B1907, B1908 or
74 may be output at this time, but they are not related to
this check.
OK
REPLACE FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT
ASSEMBLY RH
NG
2
CHECK CONNECTOR
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the SST from connector C.
(d) Check that the floor wire connector (on the front seat
outer belt RH side) is not damaged.
OK:
Lock button is not disengaged, or the claw of the
lock is not deformed or damaged.
RS
RS–158
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE NO. 2 FLOOR WIRE
OK
3
RS
CHECK NO. 2 FLOOR WIRE (FRONT PASSENGER SIDE FRONT PRETENSIONER SQUIB
CIRCUIT)
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the center airbag
sensor.
(b) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
No. 2 Floor Wire
A
D C
B
Center Airbag
Sensor
Front Passenger Side
Front Pretensioner Squib
R-
P23
C
Specified Condition
P23-1 (R+) - Body ground
Below 1 V
P23-2 (R-) - Body ground
Below 1 V
(d) Turn the power switch OFF.
(e) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(f) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Connector C
R+
Tester Connection
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
P23-1 (R+) - P23-2 (R-)
Below 1 Ω
P23-1 (R+) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
P23-2 (R-) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
C114784E07
(g) Release the activation prevention mechanism built into
connector B (see page RS-31).
(h) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
P23-1 (R+) - P23-2 (R-)
1 MΩ or higher
NG
OK
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
REPAIR OR REPLACE NO. 2 FLOOR WIRE
RS–159
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
Source Voltage Drop
DESCRIPTION
The SRS is equipped with a voltage-increase circuit (DC-DC converter) in the center airbag sensor in
case the source voltage drops.
When the source voltage drops, the voltage-increase circuit (DC-DC converter) functions to increase the
voltage of the SRS to a normal working level.
When a malfunction occurs in this circuit, no DTCs are output (a normal system code is output). If a
source voltage drop occurs, the SRS warning light comes on.
A malfunction in this circuit is not recorded in the center airbag sensor.
The SRS warning light automatically goes off when the source voltage returns to normal.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Center Airbag
Sensor
IGN
from Battery
IG2
E1
E2
C131001E02
RS
RS–160
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR - BATTERY)
A18
RS
IG2
G027651E31
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the connectors from the center airbag
sensor.
(d) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(e) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
A18-21 (IG2) - Body
ground
Power switch ON (IG)
11 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR, CHARGING SYSTEM AND
BATTERY
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR - BODY GROUND)
(a) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
A18
E2
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A18-25 (E1) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
A18-26 (E2) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
E1
G027651E32
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
3
CHECK SRS WARNING LIGHT
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the center airbag sensor connector.
(d) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(e) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 6
seconds.
(f) Operate all components of the electrical system
(defogger, wiper, headlight, heater, blower, etc.) and
check that the SRS warning light does not come on.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–161
OK:
SRS warning light does not come on.
NG
OK
END
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
RS
RS–162
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
SRS Warning Light Remains ON
DESCRIPTION
RS
The SRS warning light is located on the combination meter. When the power switch is turned from OFF to
ON (IG), the SRS warning light illuminates. If the SRS is normal, the SRS warning light turns OFF
automatically after approximately 6 seconds. If there is a malfunction in the SRS, the SRS warning light
remains illuminated even after approximately 6 seconds have passed. When terminals TC and CG of the
DLC3 are connected, the DTCs are communicated through SRS warning light blinking patterns.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Combination Meter
from DOME Fuse
B
from GAUGE Fuse
IG+
ET
Center Airbag Sensor
from IGN Fuse
IG2
E1
LA
LA
E2
C130816E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT BATTERY
(a) Measure the voltage of the battery.
Standard voltage:
11 to 14 V
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
NG
RS–163
RECHARGE OR REPLACE BATTERY
OK
2
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTOR
RS
(a) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(b) Check that the connector is properly connected to the
center airbag sensor.
OK:
Connector is connected.
NG
CONNECT CONNECTOR
OK
3
PREPARE FOR INSPECTION
CAUTION:
Be sure to perform the following procedures before
troubleshooting to avoid unexpected airbag deployment.
(a) Disconnect the connector from the center airbag sensor.
(b) Disconnect the connector from the steering pad
connector.
NEXT
4
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
Wire Harness Side
A18
E1
IG2
H100389E13
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Measure the voltage and resistance of the wire harness
side connector.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A18-21 (IG2) - Body ground
8 to 14 V
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A18-25 (E1) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
RS–164
5
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
CHECK COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY (POWER SOURCE)
(a) Disconnect the C10 meter connector.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
RS
C10
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
C10-21 - Body ground
8 to 14 V
NG
H100390E02
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
6
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR - COMBINATION METER)
(a) Disconnect the A18 sensor connector.
(b) Disconnect the C10 meter connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Center Airbag Sensor
LA
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A18-14 (LA) - C10-11
Below 1 Ω
A18
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
Combination Meter
C10
H100391E09
OK
7
CHECK SRS WARNING LIGHT (OPERATION)
(a) Disconnect the A18 ECU connector with the C10 meter
connector connected.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Check that the warning light illuminates for 6 seconds
after turning the power switch ON (IG).
OK:
Warning light illuminates for 6 seconds after
turning power switch ON (IG).
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
NG
RS–165
REPLACE COMBINATION METER
ASSEMBLY
OK
8
RS
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the A18 sensor connector.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
A18
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A18-14 (LA) - Body ground
8 to 14 V
NG
LA
H100389E14
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
9
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Replace the center airbag sensor.
(b) Check that the SRS warning light illuminates normally.
OK:
SRS warning light illuminates normally.
NG
OK
END
REPLACE COMBINATION METER
ASSEMBLY
RS–166
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
SRS Warning Light does not Come ON
DESCRIPTION
RS
The SRS warning light is located on the combination meter. When the power switch is turned from OFF to
ON (IG), the SRS warning light illuminates. If the SRS is normal, the SRS warning light turns off
automatically after approximately 6 seconds. If there is a malfunction in the SRS, the SRS warning light
remains illuminated even after approximately 6 seconds have passed. When terminals TC and CG of the
DLC3 are connected, the DTCs are communicated through SRS warning light blinking patterns.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Combination Meter
from DOME Fuse
B
from GAUGE Fuse
IG+
ET
Center Airbag Sensor
from IGN Fuse
IG2
E1
LA
LA
E2
C130816E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTORS
(a) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(b) Check that the connectors are properly connected to the
center airbag sensor and combination meter.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–167
OK:
Connectors are connected.
NG
CONNECT CONNECTORS
OK
RS
2
CHECK COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the C10 meter connector.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
C10
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
C10-21 - Body ground
8 to 14 V
NG
H100390E02
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
3
CHECK SRS WARNING LIGHT (OPERATION)
(a) Disconnect the A18 sensor connector with the C10
meter connector connected.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Check that the warning light illuminates for 6 seconds
after turning the power switch ON (IG).
OK:
Warning light illuminates for 6 seconds after
turning power switch ON (IG).
NG
REPLACE COMBINATION METER
ASSEMBLY
OK
4
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Replace the center airbag sensor.
(b) Check that the SRS warning light illuminates normally.
OK:
SRS warning light illuminates normally.
NG
OK
END
REPLACE COMBINATION METER
ASSEMBLY
RS–168
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
TC and CG Terminal Circuit
DESCRIPTION
RS
DTC output mode is set by connecting terminals TC and CG of the DLC3. The DTCs are communicated
through SRS warning light blinking patterns.
HINT:
When one or more of the warning lights blinks continuously, the cause may be a ground short in the wiring
of terminal TC of the DLC3 or an internal ground short in each ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Skid Control ECU with Actuator
TC
Center Airbag Sensor
TC
ECM
TC
DLC3
TC
CG
H101256E03
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – AIRBAG SYSTEM
RS–169
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
CAUTION:
Be sure to perform the following procedures before troubleshooting to avoid unexpected airbag
deployment.
1. Turn the power switch OFF.
2. Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
1
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (DLC3 - CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR AND BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the A18 sensor connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
DLC3
Tester Connection
D1
Specified Condition
D1-13 (TC) - A18-15 (TC)
Below 1 Ω
D1-4 (CG) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
A18-15 (TC) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
TC
CG
NG
Center Airbag Sensor
A18
TC
H100393E06
OK
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–169
OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION
SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
1.
2.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE FOR VEHICLE INVOLVED
IN ACCIDENT
(a) Perform the zero point calibration and sensitivity
check if any of the following conditions apply.
• The occupant classification ECU is replaced.
• Accessories (seatback tray and seat cover, etc.)
are installed.
• The front passenger seat is removed from the
vehicle.
• The passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator (OFF)
comes on when the front passenger seat is not
occupied.
• The vehicle is brought to the workshop for repair
due to an accident or a collision.
NOTICE:
When a vehicle involved in an accident is
brought into the workshop for repair, check the
flatness of the floor where the front passenger
seat is mounted. If the flatness is not within +3.0 mm (+-0.118 in.), adjust it to the specified
range.
NOTICE FOR INITIALIZATION
When disconnecting the negative (-) battery terminal,
initialize the following system after the terminal is
reconnected.
System Name
See page
Power Window Control System
IN-32
3.
NOTICE FOR HYBRID SYSTEM ACTIVATION
• When the warning light is illuminated or the battery
has been disconnected and reconnected, pressing
the power switch may not start the system on the first
try. If so, press the power switch again.
• With the power switch's power mode changed to ON
(IG), disconnect the battery. If the key not in the key
slot during reconnection, DTC B2799 may be output.
RS
RS–170
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
RS
PASSENGER AIRBAG ON / OFF INDICATOR
#+4$#) 1(( 10
FRONT OCCUPANT
CLASSIFICATION
SENSOR LH
2#55'0)'4
FRONT OCCUPANT
CLASSIFICATION
SENSOR RH
CENTER AIRBAG
SENSOR ASSEMBLY
FRONT SEAT INNER
BELT ASSEMBLY
REAR OCCUPANT
CLASSIFICATION
SENSOR RH
REAR OCCUPANT
CLASSIFICATION
SENSOR LH
OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
C128660E01
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–171
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
Front Seat Inner Belt Assembly RH (Buckle Switch RH)
RS
Front Occupant Classification Sensor LH
Occupant Classification
ECU
Front Occupant Classification Sensor RH
Rear Occupant Classification Sensor LH
Rear Occupant Classification Sensor RH
DLC3
Center Airbag
Sensor
Passenger Airbag ON / OFF Indicator
H100928E04
RS–172
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
RS
Passenger Airbag
ON/OFF Indicator
Front Passenger
Airbag
GENERAL
(a) The front passenger occupant classification system
judges whether the front passenger seat is occupied
or not in accordance with the seat belt buckle
status; and whether the seat is occupied by an adult
or child (with child seat) in accordance with the load
that is applied to the front passenger seat. Thus,
when appropriate, it restricts the deployment of the
front passenger airbag, front passenger side airbag,
and the front passenger seat belt pretensioner. In
addition, the system informs the driver of the result
of the judgment through the use of the airbag ON/
OFF indicator.
Occupant Classification
Sensor
Occupant Classification
ECU
*1
Center
Airbag
Sensor
Assembly
Front Passenger Side
Front Seat Side Airbag
*2
Front Passenger Side
Front Seat Outer Belt
(Seat Belt Pretensioner)
Seat Belt Buckle Switch
DLC3
*3
Unoccupied judgment: *1, *2 and *3 are deactivated
Combination Meter
(SRS Warning Light) Child or child seat judgment: *1 and *2 are deactivated
C130895E04
2.
Component
MAIN COMPONENTS
Description
Occupant Classification Sensor
Outputs voltages to occupant classification ECU in accordance with
load applied to sensor
Occupant Classification ECU
Constantly monitors weight of front passenger seat load, and judges
occupancy condition in accordance with signals from occupant
classification sensors and seat belt buckle switch
Passenger Airbag ON / OFF Indicator
Passenger airbag ON indicator illuminates when front passenger and
front passenger side airbags activated. Airbag OFF indicator
illuminates when front passenger and front passenger side airbags
deactivated.
Seat Belt Buckle Switch
Detects whether seat belt is fastened and outputs appropriate signals
to occupant classification ECU
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–173
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
• Use the following procedures to troubleshoot the occupant
classification system.
• *: Use the intelligent tester.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
PASSENGER AIRBAG ON/OFF INDICATOR CHECK
NEXT
3
DTC CHECK (Present and Past DTC)*
(a) Check for DTCs (see page RS-182 ).
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC is output.
A
DTC is not output.
B
B
GO TO PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
A
4
DTC CHART
NEXT
5
REPAIR OR REPLACEMENT
NEXT
6
DTC CLEARANCE (Present and Past DTCs)*
(a) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-182).
NEXT
7
DTC CHECK (Present and Past DTCs)*
(a) Check for DTCs (see page RS-182 ).
RS
RS–174
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
Result
Result
RS
Proceed to
DTC is not output.
A
DTC is output.
B
B
Go to step 5
A
8
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS SIMULATION
(a) Check the passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator condition
(see page RS-179).
Result
Result
Proceed to
Passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator is operating normally.
A
Passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator (OFF) is not operating
normally.
B
B
A
9
NEXT
END
CONFIRMATION TEST
Go to step 5
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–175
INITIALIZATION
1.
ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
NOTICE:
Make sure that the front passenger seat is not
occupied before performing the operation.
HINT:
Perform the zero point calibration and sensitivity check if
any of the following conditions apply.
• The occupant classification ECU is replaced.
• Accessories (seat cover, etc.) are installed.
• The front passenger seat is removed from the vehicle.
• The passenger airbag ON / OFF indicator (OFF)
comes on when the front passenger seat is not
occupied.
• The vehicle is brought to the workshop for repair due
to an accident or a collision.
(a) Zero point calibration and sensitivity check
procedures:
HINT:
Make sure that the zero point calibration has
finished normally, and then perform the sensitivity
check.
(1) Adjust the seat position in accordance with the
table below.
Adjustment Item
Position
Slide Direction
Rearmost position
Reclining Angle
Upright position
Headrest Height
Lowest position
Lifter Height
Lowest position
(2) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to
the DLC3.
(3) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Intelligent Tester
DLC3
CAN VIM
B126098E01
RS
RS–176
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
(4) Perform the zero point calibration by following
the prompts on the tester screen.
ZERO POINT CALIBRATION PROCEDURE
1: DIAGNOSIS - 1: OBD/MOBD - MODEL YEAR - MODEL SELECTION - 9: OCCUPANT DETECT
Refer to the following screen flowchart.
RS
ZERO CALIBRATION
Perform sensitivity check.
Perform DTC check and repair.
Sensor information is shown
as OK, MAX. or MIN. in [
].
If MAX. or MIN. is displayed,
replace front seat outer belt
assembly.
C
C113452E11
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual
for further details.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
(5)
(6)
(7)
(8)
RS–177
OK:
COMPLETED is displayed.
Perform the sensitivity check by following the
prompts on the tester screen.
Confirm that the beginning sensor reading is
within the standard range.
Standard range:
-3.2 to 3.2 kg (-7 to 7 lb)
Place a 30 kg (66.14 lb) weight (e.g. a lead
mass) onto the front passenger seat.
Confirm that the sensitivity is within the standard
range.
SENSITIVITY CHECK PROCEDURE
1: DIAGNOSIS
1: OBD/MOBD
MODEL YEAR
MODEL SELECTION
9: OCCUPANT DETECT
.
*1: The unit can be changed by entering the following menu
items on an intelligent tester.
P
[Unit Selection Screen]
.
1: DIAGNOSIS
9: SETUP
4: UNIT CONVERSION
WEIGHT (kg = lbs)
C
C130896E02
Standard range:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
HINT:
• When performing the sensitivity check, use a
solid metal weight (the check result may not
be accurate if a liquid weight is used).
RS
RS–178
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
• If the sensitivity deviates from the standard
range, retighten the bolts of the front
passenger seat taking care not to deform the
seat rail. After performing this procedure, if
the sensitivity is not within the standard
range, replace the front seat RH.
• If the zero point calibration has not finished
normally, replace the front seat RH.
RS–179
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
• Use the table below to help determine the cause of the
problem symptom. The potential cases of the symptoms
are listed in order of probability in the "Suspected Area"
column of the table. Check each symptom by checking the
suspected areas in the order they are listed. Replace parts
as necessary.
• Proceed to the troubleshooting procedures for each circuit
in the table below.
Occupant classification ECU
Symptom
The front passenger seat condition differs from the
indication of the passenger airbag ON / OFF indicator
(DTC is not output).
Suspected area
Trouble in Passenger Airbag ON / OFF Indicator
See page
RS-260
RS
RS–180
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
CHECK OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(a) Measure the voltage of the connector.
O4
O5
RS
H100909E09
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
+B (O4-1) - GND (O4-3)
L - W-B
+B power source
Always
10 to 14 V
DIA (O4-2) - GND (O4-3)
W - W-B
Diagnosis (DLC3)
Power switch ON (IG)
Pulse generation
GND (O4-3) - Body
ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
FSR- (O4-4) - GND (O4-3)
Y-B - W-B
Center airbag sensor
communication line
Always
Below 1 Ω
BGND (O4-5) - GND (O43)
R - W-B
Passenger side buckle
switch ground line
Always
Below 1 Ω
IG (O4-7) - GND (O4-3)
B - W-B
IG power source
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
FSR+ (O4-8) - FSR- (O44)
Y - Y-B
Center airbag sensor
communication line
Power switch ON (IG)
Pulse generation
BSW (O4-9) - BGND (O45)
G-R
Passenger side buckle
switch line
Buckle switch ON
Buckle switch OFF
Pulse generation
SGD1 (O5-1) - GND (O43)
G - W-B
Front occupant
classification sensor LH
ground line
Always
Below 1 Ω
SGD2 (O5-2) - GND (O43)
O - W-B
Front occupant
classification sensor RH
ground line
Always
Below 1 Ω
SGD3 (O5-3) - GND (O43)
W - W-B
Rear occupant
classification sensor LH
ground line
Always
Below 1 Ω
SGD4 (O5-4) - GND (O43)
BR - W-B
Rear occupant
classification sensor RH
ground line
Always
Below 1 Ω
R-G
Front occupant
classification sensor LH
power supply line
Power switch ON (IG), a
load is applied to front
occupant classification
sensor LH
4.5 to 5.1 V
W-O
Front occupant
classification sensor RH
power supply line
Power switch ON (IG), a
load is applied to front
occupant classification
sensor RH
4.5 to 5.1 V
GR - W
Rear occupant
classification sensor LH
power supply line
Power switch ON (IG), a
load is applied to rear
occupant classification
sensor LH
4.5 to 5.1 V
V - BR
Rear occupant
classification sensor RH
power supply line
Power switch ON (IG), a
load is applied to rear
occupant classification
sensor RH
4.5 to 5.1 V
SVC1 (O5-11) - SGD1
(O5-1)
SVC2 (O5-12) - SGD2
(O5-2)
SVC3 (O5-5) - SGD3 (O53)
SVC4 (O5-6) - SGD4 (O54)
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
SIG1 (O5-7) - SGD1 (O51)
SIG2 (O5-8) - SGD2 (O52)
SIG3 (O5-9) - SGD3 (O53)
SIG4 (O5-10) - SGD4 (O54)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
RS–181
Specified Condition
SB - G
Front occupant
classification sensor LH
signal line
Power switch ON (IG), a
load is applied to front
occupant classification
sensor LH
L-O
Front occupant
classification sensor RH
signal line
Power switch ON (IG), a
load is applied to front
occupant classification
sensor RH
0.2 to 4.7 V
Y-W
Rear occupant
classification sensor LH
signal line
Power switch ON (IG), a
load is applied to rear
occupant classification
sensor LH
0.2 to 4.7 V
R - BR
Rear occupant
classification sensor RH
signal line
Power switch ON (IG), a
load is applied to rear
occupant classification
sensor RH
0.2 to 4.7 V
0.2 to 4.7 V
RS
RS–182
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
1.
DESCRIPTION
The occupant classification ECU controls the functions of
the occupant classification System on the vehicle. Data
of the occupant classification system can be read in the
Data Link Connector 3 (DLC3) of the vehicle. When the
system seems to be malfunctioning, use the intelligent
tester to check for a malfunction and perform repairs.
2.
CHECK DLC3
The ECU uses the ISO 15765-4 for communication. The
terminal arrangement of the DLC3 complies with ISO
15031-3 and matches the ISO 15765-4 format.
RS
CG SG CANH SIL
CANL
BAT
H100769E16
Symbols (Terminal No.)
SIL (7) - SG (5)
Terminal Description
Bus + line
Condition
During transmission
Specified Condition
Pulse generation
CG (4) - Body ground
Chassis ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
SG (5) - Body ground
Signal ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
BAT (16) - Body ground
Battery positive
Always
11 to 14 V
CANH (6) - CANL (14)
HIGH-Level CAN bus line
Power switch is OFF*
54 to 69 Ω
CANH (6) - Battery positive
HIGH-Level CAN bus line
Power switch is OFF*
1 kΩ or more
CANH (6) - CG (4)
HIGH-Level CAN bus line
Power switch is OFF*
1 kΩ or more
CANL (14) - Battery positive
LOW-level CAN bus line
Power switch is OFF*
1 MΩ or more
CANL (14) - CG (4)
LOW-level CAN bus line
Power switch is OFF*
1 MΩ or more
NOTICE:
*: Before measuring the resistance, leave the vehicle
as is for at least 1 minute and do not operate the
power switch, any switches or doors.
If the result is not as specified, the DLC3 may have a
malfunction. Repair or replace the harness and
connector.
HINT:
Connect the cable of the intelligent tester (with CAN
VIM) to the DLC3, turn the power switch ON and attempt
to use the tester. If the display indicates that a
communication error has occurred, there is a problem
either with the vehicle or with the tester.
• If communication is normal when the tester is
connected to another vehicle, inspect the DLC3 on
the original vehicle.
• If communication is still not possible when the tool is
connected to another vehicle, the problem is probably
in the tester itself. Consult the Service Department
listed in the tester's instruction manual.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
3.
Vibrate Slightly
Shake Slightly
Vibrate Slightly
D025083E03
4.
RS–183
SYMPTOM SIMULATION
HINT:
The most difficult case in troubleshooting is when no
symptoms occur. In such cases, a thorough customer
problem analysis must be carried out. A simulation of the
same or similar conditions and environment in which the
problem occurred in the customer's vehicle should be
carried out. No matter how much skill or experience a
technician has, troubleshooting without confirming the
problem symptoms will lead to important repairs being
overlooked and mistakes or delays.
This leads to a standstill in troubleshooting.
(a) Vibration method:
When vibration seems to be the major cause.
HINT:
Perform the simulation method only during the
primary check period (for approximately 6 seconds
after the power switch is turned ON (IG)).
(1) Slightly vibrate the part of the sensor considered
to be the cause of the problem with your fingers
and check whether the malfunction occurs.
HINT:
Shaking the relays too strongly may result in
open relays.
(2) Slightly shake the connector vertically and
horizontally.
(3) Slightly shake the wire harness vertically and
horizontally.
The connector joint and fulcrum of the vibration
are the major areas to be checked thoroughly.
(b) Simulation method for DTC B1795:
Turn the power switch from the OFF to the ON (IG)
position, hold the position for 10 seconds, and then
turn it back to the OFF position again 50 times in a
row.
HINT:
DTC B1795 is output if the occupant classification
ECU receives the power switch OFF - ON (IG) OFF signal 50 times in a row when a malfunction
occurs in the power circuit for the occupant
classification system.
FUNCTION OF PASSENGER AIRBAG ON/OFF
INDICATOR
(a) Initial check
(1) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(2) The passenger airbag ON /OFF indicator (ON
and OFF) comes on for approximately 4
seconds, then goes off for approximately 2
seconds.
RS
RS–184
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
(3) Approximately 6 seconds after the power switch
is turned to the ON (IG) position, the passenger
airbag ON/OFF indicator will be ON/OFF
depending on the conditions listed below.
Condition
RS
ON Indicator
OFF Indicator
Vacant
OFF
OFF
Adult is seated
ON
OFF
Child is seated
OFF
ON
Child restraint system is set
OFF
ON
Front passenger occupant classification
system failure
OFF
ON
HINT:
• The passenger airbag ON / OFF indicator
operates based on the timing chart below in
order to check the indicator light circuit.
on (IG)
Power Switch
off
Passenger Airbag
ON Indicator
2 sec.
4 sec.
2 sec.
ON
OFF
Passenger Airbag
OFF Indicator
4 sec.
ON
OFF
ON/OFF condition depends on the
front passenger detection results.
H043700E21
• When the occupant classification system has
trouble, both the SRS warning light and the
passenger airbag OFF indicator (OFF) come
on. In this case, check the DTCs in the airbag
system first.
5.
#+4$#) 1(( 10
2#55'0)'4
C131086
CHECK PASSENGER AIRBAG ON/OFF INDICATOR
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Check that the passenger airbag ON/OFF indicators
come on for approximately 4 seconds, then go off
for approximately 2 seconds.
HINT:
Refer to the table in the previous step regarding the
passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator when
approximately 6 seconds have elapsed after the
power switch is turned ON (IG).
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–185
DTC CHECK / CLEAR
1.
Intelligent Tester
2.
DLC3
CAN VIM
B126098E01
CHECK DTC
HINT:
• When DTC B1650/23 is detected as a result of
troubleshooting for the airbag system, troubleshoot
the occupant classification system.
• Use the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to read and
clear DTCs, otherwise the DTCs cannot be read and
cleared.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Check for DTCs by following the prompts on the
tester screen.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual for
further details.
Clear DTC
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Clear the DTCs by following the prompts on the
tester screen.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual for
further details.
RS
RS–186
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST
HINT:
Using the intelligent tester's DATA LIST allows switch, sensor,
actuator and other item values to be read without removing
any parts. Reading the DATA LIST early in troubleshooting is
one way to save time.
RS
1.
Intelligent Tester
DATA LIST FOR OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Read the DATA LIST on the tester's screen.
DLC3
CAN VIM
B126098E01
Occupant classification ECU
Item
Measurement Item/
Range (Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
ON/OFF
-
UNSET/SET
-
IG SW
Power switch condition/
ON: Power switch ON (IG)
OFF: Power switch OFF
P BUCKLE SW
Buckle switch (Front passenger
side)/
UNSET: Front passenger side
seat belt is unfastened
SET: Front passenger side seat
belt is fastened
NG: Front passenger side seat
belt is malfunctioning
Front passenger CLASS
Front passenger classification/
AF05: Adult (36 to 54 kg (79.37 to
119.05 lb)) is seated
AM50: Adult (more than 54 kg
(119.05 lb)) is seated
CHILD: Child (less than 36 kg
(79.37 lb)) is seated
CRS: Child restraint system and
front passenger side buckle
switch ON, then 7 to 36 kg (15.43
to 79.37 lb) is set
OFF: Vacant
AF05/AM50/CHILD/CRS/OFF
-
SENS RANGE INF
Sensor range information/
OK: The sensor value is within
the range
NG: The sensor value is outside
the range
OK
-
FL SENS RANGE
Front left sensor range
information/
OK: Sensor range is -17 to 27 kg
(-37.48 to 59.52 lb)
Min.: Less than -17 kg (-37.48 lb)
Max.: More than 27 kg (59.52 lb)
OK
-
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–187
Measurement Item/
Range (Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
FR SENS RANGE
Front right sensor range
information/
OK: Sensor range is -17 to 27 kg
(-37.48 to 59.52 lb)
Min.: Less than -17 kg (-37.48 lb)
Max.: More than 27 kg (59.52 lb)
OK
-
RL SENS RANGE
Rear left sensor range
information/
OK: Sensor range is -17 to 37 kg
(-37.48 to 81.57 lb)
Min.: Less than -17 kg (-37.48 lb)
Max.: More than 37 kg (81.57 lb)
OK
-
RR SENS RANGE
Rear right sensor range
information/
OK: Sensor range is -17 to 37 kg
(-37.48 to 81.57 lb)
Min.: Less than -17 kg (-37.48 lb)
Max.: More than 37 kg (81.57 lb)
OK
-
FL SENS VOL
Front left sensor voltage/
Min.: 0 V
Max.: 19.8 V
0 to 4.7 V
-
FR SENS VOL
Front right sensor voltage/
Min.: 0 V
Max.: 19.8 V
0 to 4.7 V
-
RL SENS VOL
Rear left sensor voltage/
Min.: 0 V
Max.: 19.8 V
0 to 4.7 V
-
RR SENS VOL
Rear right sensor voltage/
Min.: 0 V
Max.: 19.8 V
0 to 4.7 V
-
FL SENS WEIGHT
Front left sensor weight
information/
Min.: -17 kg (-37.48 lb)
Max.: 27 kg (59.52 lb)
-17 to 27 kg
(-37.48 to 59.52 lb)
-
FR SENS WEIGHT
Front right sensor weight
information/
Min.: -17 kg (-37.48 lb)
Max.: 27 kg (59.52 lb)
-17 to 27 kg
(-37.48 to 59.52 lb)
-
RL SENS WEIGHT
Rear left sensor weight
information/
Min.: -17 kg (-37.48 lb)
Max.: 37 kg (81.57 lb)
-17 to 37 kg
(-37.48 to 81.57 lb)
-
RR SENS WEIGHT
Rear right sensor weight
information/
Min.: -17 kg (-37.48 lb)
Max.: 37 kg (81.57 lb)
-17 to 37 kg
(-37.48 to 81.57 lb)
-
TOTAL WEIGHT
Total weight information/
Min.: -68 kg (-149.91 lb)
Max.: 128 kg (282.19 lb)
-68 to 128 kg
(-149.91 to 282.19 lb)
-
#PRESENT CODES
Number of present DTCs
Min.: 0, Max.: 255
0
-
#PAST CODES
Number of past DTCs
Min.: 0, Max.: 255
0
-
Item
RS
RS–188
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
If a trouble code is displayed during the DTC check, check
the circuit listed for the code in the table below (proceed to
the page listed for that circuit).
Occupant classification system
RS
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
See page
B1771
Passenger Side Buckle Switch
Circuit Malfunction
1. Floor wire
2. Front seat inner belt
assembly (Buckle switch RH)
3. Occupant classification ECU
RS-187
B1780
Front Occupant Classification
Sensor LH Circuit Malfunction
1. Front seat wire RH
2. Front seat assembly RH
(Front occupant classification
sensor RH)
3. Occupant classification ECU
RS-193
B1781
Front Occupant Classification
Sensor RH Circuit Malfunction
1. Front seat wire RH
2. Front seat assembly RH
(Front occupant classification
sensor RH)
3. Occupant classification ECU
RS-200
B1782
Rear Occupant Classification
Sensor LH Circuit Malfunction
1. Front seat wire RH
2. Front seat assembly RH
(Rear occupant classification
sensor LH)
3. Occupant classification ECU
RS-207
B1783
Rear Occupant Classification
Sensor RH Circuit Malfunction
1. Front seat wire RH
2. Front seat assembly RH
(Rear occupant classification
sensor RH)
3. Occupant classification ECU
RS-214
B1785
Front Occupant Classification
Sensor LH Collision Detection
1. Front seat assembly RH
(Front occupant classification
sensor LH)
2. Occupant classification ECU
RS-221
B1786
Front Occupant Classification
Sensor RH Collision Detection
1. Front seat assembly RH
(Front occupant classification
sensor RH)
2. Occupant classification ECU
RS-225
B1787
Rear Occupant Classification
Sensor LH Collision Detection
1. Front seat assembly RH
(Rear occupant classification
sensor LH)
2. Occupant classification ECU
RS-229
B1788
Rear Occupant Classification
Sensor RH Collision Detection
1. Front seat assembly RH
(Rear occupant classification
sensor RH)
2. Occupant classification ECU
RS-233
B1790
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly
Communication Circuit
Malfunction
1. Floor wire
2. Occupant classification ECU
3. Center airbag sensor
assembly
RS-237
B1793
Occupant Classification Sensor
Power Supply Circuit Malfunction
1. Front seat wire RH
2. Front seat assembly RH
(Occupant classification
sensors)
3. Occupant classification ECU
RS-243
B1794
Open in Occupant Classification
ECU Battery Positive Line
1. Wire harness
2. Occupant classification ECU
RS-251
B1795
Occupant Classification ECU
Malfunction
1.
2.
3.
4.
5.
RS-255
Battery
ECU-B Fuse
No. 2 floor wire
Front seat inner belt RH
Occupant classification ECU
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
DTC No.
B1796
Detection Item
Sleep Operation Failure of
Occupant Classification ECU
Trouble Area
Occupant classification ECU
RS–189
See page
RS-258
RS
RS–190
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
DTC
Passenger Side Buckle Switch Circuit Malfunction
B1771
DESCRIPTION
RS
The passenger side buckle switch circuit consists of the occupant classification ECU and the front seat
inner belt RH.
DTC B1771 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the passenger side buckle switch circuit.
Troubleshoot DTC B1771 first when DTCs B1771 and B1795 are output simultaneously.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
B1771
When one of following conditions is met:
• Occupant classification ECU detects line short
signal, open signal, short to ground signal or short
to B+ signal in the passenger side buckle switch
circuit for 2 seconds
• Passenger side buckle switch malfunction
• Occupant classification ECU malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Floor wire
Front seat inner belt RH (Buckle switch RH)
Occupant classification ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
Front Seat Inner Belt RH
Occupant Classification ECU
BSW
BGND
C123546E05
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–191
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• If troubleshooting (wire harness inspection) is difficult to perform, remove the front passenger seat
installation bolts to see the undersurface of the seat cushion.
• In the above case, hold the seat so that it does not tip over. Holding the seat for a long period of time
may cause a problem, such as seat rail deformation. Hold the seat up only for as long as necessary.
1
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-182).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor.
(c) Turn the power switch OFF.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(e) Check the DTCs (see page RS-182).
OK:
DTC B1771 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1771 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
NG
2
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTOR
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Check that the connectors are properly connected to the
occupant classification ECU and the front seat inner belt
RH.
OK:
The connectors are properly connected.
NG
OK
CONNECT CONNECTOR
RS
RS–192
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (TO B+)
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the occupant
classification ECU and the front seat inner belt RH.
(b) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Floor Wire
RS
D
A
C
Front Seat Inner
Belt RH
B
Occupant
Classification
ECU
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
O4-9 (BSW) - Body ground
Below 1 V
O4-5 (BGND) - Body ground
Below 1 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
Connector B
BGND
O4
BSW
H100918E09
OK
4
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (FOR OPEN)
Floor Wire
D C
B A Occupant
Classification
ECU
Front Seat
Inner Belt RH
Connector C
B16
Connector B
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Using a service wire, connect terminals B16-2 and B16-1
of connector C.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the
terminals of the connector when connecting them.
(d) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
O4-9 (BSW) - O4-5 (BGND)
Below 1 Ω
O4
NG
BSW
BGND
Service Wire
C130813E01
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
5
RS–193
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (FOR SHORT)
(a) Disconnect the service wire from connector C.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Floor Wire
D
A
C
Front Seat Inner
Belt RH
B
Occupant
Classification
ECU
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
O4-9 (BSW) - O4-5 (BGND)
1 MΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
Connector B
BGND
O4
BSW
H100918E10
OK
6
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (TO GROUND)
(a) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Floor Wire
D
A
C
Front Seat Inner
Belt RH
B
Occupant
Classification
ECU
Connector B
BGND
O4
BSW
OK
H100918E10
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
O4-9 (BSW) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
O4-5 (BGND) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
RS
RS–194
7
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Connect the connectors to the occupant classification
ECU and the front seat inner belt RH.
(b) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-182).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor.
(e) Turn the power switch OFF.
(f) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(g) Check the DTCs (see page RS-182).
OK:
DTC B1771 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1771 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
RS
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
NG
8
REPLACE FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Replace the front seat inner belt RH (see page SB-5).
HINT:
Perform the inspection using parts from a normal vehicle
if possible.
(d) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(e) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(f) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-182).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor.
(g) Turn the power switch OFF.
(h) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(i) Check the DTCs (see page RS-182).
OK:
DTC B1771 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1771 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
NG
END
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
9
RS–195
REPLACE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Replace the occupant classification ECU.
NEXT
10
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Using the intelligent tester, perform the zero point
calibration (see page RS-174).
OK:
COMPLETED is displayed.
NEXT
11
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform the sensitivity check
(see page RS-174).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NEXT
END
RS
RS–196
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
DTC
B1780
Front Occupant Classification Sensor LH Circuit Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
RS
The front occupant classification sensor LH circuit consists of the occupant classification ECU and the
front occupant classification sensor LH.
DTC B1780 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the front occupant classification sensor LH
circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
B1780
When one of following conditions is met:
• Occupant classification ECU detects line short
signal, open signal, short to ground signal or short
to B+ signal in the front occupant classification
sensor LH circuit for 2 seconds
• Front occupant classification sensor LH malfunction
• Occupant classification ECU malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Front seat wire RH
Front seat RH (Front occupant classification sensor
LH)
Occupant classification ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
Front Occupant Classification
Sensor LH
Occupant Classification ECU
SVC1
SVC1
SIG1
SIG1
SGD1
SGD1
C128670E05
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–197
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• If troubleshooting (wire harness inspection) is difficult to perform, remove the front passenger seat
installation bolts to see the undersurface of the seat cushion.
• In the above case, hold the seat so that it does not tip over. Holding the seat for a long period of time
may cause a problem, such as seat rail deformation. Hold the seat up only for as long as necessary.
1
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-182).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor.
(c) Turn the power switch OFF.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(e) Check the DTCs (see page RS-182).
OK:
DTC B1780 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1780 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
NG
2
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTOR
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Check that the connectors are properly connected to the
occupant classification ECU and the front occupant
classification sensor LH.
OK:
The connectors are properly connected.
NG
OK
CONNECT CONNECTOR
RS
RS–198
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH (TO B+)
Front Seat Wire RH
RS
C
B
D
A
Occupant
Classification
ECU
Front Occupant
Classification
Sensor LH
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the occupant
classification ECU and the front occupant classification
sensor LH.
(b) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
O5-1 (SGD1) - Body ground
Below 1 V
O5-7 (SIG1) - Body ground
Below 1 V
O5-11 (SVC1) - Body ground
Below 1 V
NG
Connector B
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE
RH
O5
SGD1
SIG1
SVC1
C130827E01
OK
4
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH (FOR OPEN)
Front Seat Wire RH
D
C
Front Occupant
Classification
Sensor LH
A
B Occupant
Classification
ECU
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Using a service wire, connect terminals O6-1 (SVC1)
and O6-3 (SGD1), and connect terminals O6-2 (SIG1)
and O6-3 (SGD1) of connector C.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the
terminals of the connector when connecting them.
(d) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Connector C
O5
SGD1
SGD1
O6
SVC1
SIG1
SIG1
Specified Condition
O5-7 (SIG1) - O5-1 (SGD1)
Below 1 Ω
O5-11 (SVC1) - O5-1 (SGD1)
Below 1 Ω
NG
SVC1
Service Wire
H100920E22
OK
Tester Connection
Connector B
Service Wire
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE
RH
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
5
RS–199
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH (FOR SHORT)
Front Seat Wire RH
C
(a) Disconnect the service wire from connector C.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
B
D
A
Occupant
Classification
ECU
Front Occupant
Classification
Sensor LH
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
O5-7 (SIG1) - O5-1 (SGD1)
1 MΩ or higher
O5-11 (SVC1) - O5-1 (SGD1)
1 MΩ or higher
O5-7 (SIG1) - O5-11 (SVC1)
1 MΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE
RH
Connector B
O5
SGD1
SIG1
SVC1
C130827E01
OK
6
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH (TO GROUND)
Front Seat Wire RH
C
B
D
A
Front Occupant
Classification
Sensor LH
Occupant
Classification
ECU
Connector B
O5
SGD1
SIG1
SVC1
C130827E01
OK
(a) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
O5-1 (SGD1) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
O5-7 (SIG1) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
O5-11 (SVC1) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE
RH
RS
RS–200
7
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Connect the connectors to the occupant classification
ECU and the front occupant classification sensor LH.
(b) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-182).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor.
(e) Turn the power switch OFF.
(f) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(g) Check the DTCs (see page RS-182).
OK:
DTC B1780 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1780 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
RS
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
NG
8
REPLACE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Replace the occupant classification ECU.
HINT:
Perform the inspection using parts from a normal vehicle
if possible.
NEXT
9
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Using the intelligent tester, perform the zero point
calibration (see page RS-174).
OK:
COMPLETED is displayed.
NG
OK
Go to step 12
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
10
RS–201
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform the sensitivity check
(see page RS-174).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NG
Go to step 12
OK
11
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-182).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor.
(d) Turn the power switch OFF.
(e) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(f) Check the DTCs (see page RS-182).
OK:
DTC B1780 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1780 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
END
NG
12
REPLACE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Replace the front seat RH (see page SE-1).
NEXT
13
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Using the intelligent tester, perform the zero point
calibration (see page RS-174).
OK:
COMPLETED is displayed.
RS
RS–202
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
NEXT
14
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform the sensitivity check
(see page RS-174).
Standard values:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
RS
NEXT
END
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
DTC
B1781
RS–203
Front Occupant Classification Sensor RH Circuit Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The front occupant classification sensor RH circuit consists of the occupant classification ECU and the
front occupant classification sensor RH.
DTC B1781 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the front occupant classification sensor RH
circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
B1781
When one of following conditions is met:
• Occupant classification ECU detects line short
signal, open signal, short to ground signal or short
to B+ signal in the front occupant classification
sensor RH circuit for 2 seconds
• Front occupant classification sensor RH
malfunction
• Occupant classification ECU malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Front seat wire RH
Front seat RH (Front occupant classification sensor
RH)
Occupant classification ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
Front Occupant Classification
Sensor RH
Occupant Classification ECU
SVC2
SVC2
SIG2
SIG2
SGD2
SGD2
C128670E06
RS
RS–204
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
RS
HINT:
• If troubleshooting (wire harness inspection) is difficult to perform, remove the front passenger seat
installation bolts to see the undersurface of the seat cushion.
• In the above case, hold the seat so that it does not tip over. Holding the seat for a long period of time
may cause a problem, such as seat rail deformation. Hold the seat up only for as long as necessary.
1
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-182).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor.
(c) Turn the power switch OFF.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(e) Check the DTCs (see page RS-182).
OK:
DTC B1781 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1781 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
NG
2
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTOR
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Check that the connectors are properly connected to the
occupant classification ECU and the front occupant
classification sensor RH.
OK:
The connectors are properly connected.
NG
OK
CONNECT CONNECTOR
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
3
RS–205
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH (TO B+)
Front Seat Wire RH
C
B
D
A
Occupant
Classification
ECU
Front Occupant
Classification
Sensor RH
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the occupant
classification ECU and the front occupant classification
sensor RH.
(b) Connect the cable to the negative (-) terminal battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
O5-2 (SGD2) - Body ground
Below 1 V
O5-8 (SIG2) - Body ground
Below 1 V
O5-12 (SVC2) - Body ground
Below 1 V
NG
Connector B
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE
RH
O5
SGD2
SIG2
SVC2
C130827E02
OK
4
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH (OPEN)
Front Seat Wire RH
D
C
Front Occupant
Classification
Sensor RH
A
B Occupant
Classification
ECU
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Using a service wire, connect terminals O7-1 (SVC2)
and O7-3 (SGD2), and connect terminals O7-2 (SIG2)
and O7-3 (SGD2) of connector C.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the
terminals of the connector when connecting them.
(d) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Connector C
O5
SGD2
SGD2
O7
SVC2
SIG2
SIG2
Specified Condition
O5-8 (SIG2) - O5-2 (SGD2)
Below 1 Ω
O5-12 (SVC2) - O5-2 (SGD2)
Below 1 Ω
NG
SVC2
Service Wire
H100920E23
OK
Tester Connection
Connector B
Service Wire
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE
RH
RS
RS–206
5
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH (SHORT)
Front Seat Wire RH
RS
C
(a) Disconnect the service wire from connector C.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
B
D
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
O5-8 (SIG2) - O5-2 (SGD2)
1 MΩ or higher
O5-12 (SVC2) - O5-2 (SGD2)
1 MΩ or higher
O5-8 (SIG2) - O5-12 (SVC2)
1 MΩ or higher
A
Occupant
Classification
ECU
Front Occupant
Classification
Sensor RH
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE
RH
Connector B
O5
SGD2
SIG2
SVC2
C130827E02
OK
6
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH (TO GROUND)
Front Seat Wire RH
C
B
D
A
Front Occupant
Classification
Sensor RH
Occupant
Classification
ECU
Connector B
O5
SGD2
SIG2
SVC2
C130827E02
OK
(a) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
O5-2 (SGD2) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
O5-8 (SIG2) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
O5-12 (SVC2) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE
RH
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
7
RS–207
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Connect the connectors to the occupant classification
ECU and the front occupant classification sensor RH.
(b) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-182).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor.
(e) Turn the power switch OFF.
(f) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(g) Check the DTCs (see page RS-182).
OK:
DTC B1781 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1781 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
NG
8
REPLACE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Replace the occupant classification ECU.
HINT:
Perform the inspection using parts from a normal vehicle
if possible.
NEXT
9
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Using the intelligent tester, perform the zero point
calibration (see page RS-174).
OK:
COMPLETED is displayed.
NG
OK
Go to step 12
RS
RS–208
10
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform the sensitivity check
(see page RS-174).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
RS
NG
Go to step 12
OK
11
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-182).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor.
(d) Turn the power switch OFF.
(e) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(f) Check the DTCs (see page RS-182).
OK:
DTC B1781 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1781 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
END
NG
12
REPLACE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Replace the front seat RH (see page SE-1).
NEXT
13
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Using the intelligent tester, perform the zero point
calibration (see page RS-174).
OK:
COMPLETED is displayed.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–209
NEXT
14
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform the sensitivity check
(see page RS-174).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NEXT
END
RS
RS–210
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
DTC
B1782
Rear Occupant Classification Sensor LH Circuit
Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
RS
The rear occupant classification sensor LH circuit consists of the occupant classification ECU and the rear
occupant classification sensor LH.
DTC B1782 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the rear occupant classification sensor LH
circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
B1782
When one of following conditions is met:
• Occupant classification ECU detects line short
signal, open signal, short to ground signal or short
to B+ signal in the rear occupant classification
sensor LH circuit for 2 seconds
• Rear occupant classification sensor LH malfunction
• Occupant classification ECU malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Front seat wire RH
Front seat RH (Rear occupant classification sensor
LH)
Occupant classification ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
Rear Occupant Classification
Sensor LH
Occupant Classification ECU
SVC3
SVC3
SIG3
SIG3
SGD3
SGD3
C128670E07
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–211
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• If troubleshooting (wire harness inspection) is difficult to perform, remove the front passenger seat
installation bolts to see the undersurface of the seat cushion.
• In the above case, hold the seat so that it does not tip over. Holding the seat for a long period of time
may cause a problem, such as seat rail deformation. Hold the seat up only for as long as necessary.
1
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-182).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor.
(c) Turn the power switch OFF.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(e) Check the DTCs (see page RS-182).
OK:
DTC B1782 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1782 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
NG
2
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTOR
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Check that the connectors are properly connected to the
occupant classification ECU and the rear occupant
classification sensor LH.
OK:
The connectors are properly connected.
NG
OK
CONNECT CONNECTOR
RS
RS–212
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH (TO B+)
Front Seat Wire RH
RS
C
B
D
A
Occupant
Classification
ECU
Rear Occupant
Classification
Sensor LH
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
O5-3 (SGD3) - Body ground
Below 1 V
O5-5 (SVC3) - Body ground
Below 1 V
O5-9 (SIG3) - Body ground
Below 1 V
NG
Connector B
O5
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the occupant
classification ECU and the rear occupant classification
sensor LH.
(b) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE
RH
SGD3
SVC3
SIG3
C130827E03
OK
4
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH (OPEN)
Front Seat Wire RH
D
C
Rear Occupant
Classification
Sensor LH
A
B Occupant
Classification
ECU
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Using a service wire, connect terminals O8-1 (SVC3)
and O8-3 (SGD3), and connect terminals O8-2 (SIG3)
and O8-3 (SGD3) of connector C.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the
terminals of the connector when connecting them.
(d) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Connector C
Tester Connection
Connector B
Service Wire
O5
SGD3
SGD3
O8
SVC3
SIG3
Below 1 Ω
O5-9 (SIG3) - O5-3 (SGD3)
Below 1 Ω
NG
Service Wire
H100920E24
OK
O5-5 (SVC3) - O5-3 (SGD3)
SVC3
SIG3
Specified Condition
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE
RH
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
5
RS–213
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH (SHORT)
Front Seat Wire RH
C
(a) Disconnect the service wire from connector C.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
B
D
A
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
O5-5 (SVC3) - O5-3 (SGD3)
1 MΩ or higher
Occupant
Classification
ECU
Rear Occupant
Classification
Sensor LH
NG
O5-9 (SIG3) - O5-3 (SGD3)
1 MΩ or higher
O5-5 (SVC3) - O5-9 (SIG3)
1 MΩ or higher
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE
RH
Connector B
O5
SGD3
SVC3
SIG3
C130827E03
OK
6
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH (TO GROUND)
Front Seat Wire RH
C
B
D
A
Rear Occupant
Classification
Sensor LH
Occupant
Classification
ECU
Connector B
O5
SGD3
SVC3
SIG3
C130827E03
OK
(a) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
O5-3 (SGD3) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
O5-5 (SVC3) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
O5-9 (SIG3) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE
RH
RS
RS–214
7
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Connect the connectors to the occupant classification
ECU and the rear occupant classification sensor LH.
(b) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-182).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor.
(e) Turn the power switch OFF.
(f) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(g) Check the DTCs (see page RS-182).
OK:
DTC B1782 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1782 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
RS
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
NG
8
REPLACE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Replace the occupant classification ECU.
HINT:
Perform the inspection using parts from a normal vehicle
if possible.
NEXT
9
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Using the intelligent tester, perform the zero point
calibration (see page RS-174).
OK:
COMPLETED is displayed.
NG
OK
Go to step 12
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
10
RS–215
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform the sensitivity check
(see page RS-174).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NG
Go to step 12
OK
11
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-182).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor.
(d) Turn the power switch OFF.
(e) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(f) Check the DTCs (see page RS-182).
OK:
DTC B1782 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1782 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
END
NG
12
REPLACE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Replace the front seat RH (see page SE-1).
NEXT
13
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) terminal battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Using the intelligent tester, perform the zero point
calibration (see page RS-174).
OK:
COMPLETED is displayed.
RS
RS–216
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
NEXT
14
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform the sensitivity check
(see page RS-174).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
RS
NEXT
END
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
DTC
B1783
RS–217
Rear Occupant Classification Sensor RH Circuit Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The rear occupant classification sensor RH circuit consists of the occupant classification ECU and the
rear occupant classification sensor RH.
DTC B1783 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the rear occupant classification sensor RH
circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
B1783
When one of following conditions is met:
• Occupant classification ECU detects line short
signal, open signal, short to ground signal or short
to B+ signal in the rear occupant classification
sensor RH circuit for 2 seconds
• Rear occupant classification sensor RH malfunction
• Occupant classification ECU malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Front seat wire RH
Front seat RH (Rear occupant classification sensor
RH)
Occupant classification ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
Rear Occupant Classification
Sensor RH
Occupant Classification ECU
SVC4
SVC4
SIG4
SIG4
SGD4
SGD4
C128670E08
RS
RS–218
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
RS
HINT:
• If troubleshooting (wire harness inspection) is difficult to perform, remove the front passenger seat
installation bolts to see the undersurface of the seat cushion.
• In the above case, hold the seat so that it does not tip over. Holding the seat for a long period of time
may cause a problem, such as seat rail deformation. Hold the seat up only for as long as necessary.
1
CHECK DTC
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-182).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor.
(c) Turn the power switch OFF.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(e) Check the DTCs (see page RS-182).
OK:
DTC B1783 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1783 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
NG
2
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTOR
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Check that the connectors are properly connected to the
occupant classification ECU and the rear occupant
classification sensor RH.
OK:
The connectors are properly connected.
NG
OK
CONNECT CONNECTOR
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
3
RS–219
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH (TO B+)
Front Seat Wire RH
C
B
D
A
Occupant
Classification
ECU
Rear Occupant
Classification
Sensor RH
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
O5-4 (SGD4) - Body ground
Below 1 V
O5-6 (SVC4) - Body ground
Below 1 V
O5-10 (SIG4) - Body ground
Below 1 V
NG
Connector B
O5
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the occupant
classification ECU and the rear occupant classification
sensor RH.
(b) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
SGD4
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE
RH
SVC4
SIG4
C130827E04
OK
4
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH (OPEN)
Front Seat Wire RH
D
C
Rear Occupant
Classification
Sensor RH
A
B Occupant
Classification
ECU
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Using a service wire, connect terminals O9-1 (SVC4)
and O9-3 (SGD4), and connect terminals O9-2 (SIG4)
and O9-3 (SGD4) of connector C.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the
terminals of the connector when connecting them.
(d) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Connector C
Tester Connection
Connector B
Service Wire
O5
O9
SGD4
SGD4
SVC4
SIG4
Service Wire
SVC4
H100920E25
OK
O5-6 (SVC4) - O5-4 (SGD4)
Below 1 Ω
O5-10 (SIG4) - O5-4 (SGD4)
Below 1 Ω
NG
SIG4
Specified Condition
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE
RH
RS
RS–220
5
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH (SHORT)
Front Seat Wire RH
RS
C
(a) Disconnect the service wire from connector C.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
B
D
A
Occupant
Classification
ECU
Rear Occupant
Classification
Sensor RH
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
O5-6 (SVC4) - O5-4 (SGD4)
1 MΩ or higher
O5-10 (SIG4) - O5-4 (SGD4)
1 MΩ or higher
O5-6 (SVC4) - O5-10 (SIG4)
1 MΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE
RH
Connector B
O5
SGD4
SVC4
SIG4
C130827E04
OK
6
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH (TO GROUND)
Front Seat Wire RH
C
B
D
A
Rear Occupant
Classification
Sensor RH
Occupant
Classification
ECU
Connector B
O5
SGD4
SVC4
SIG4
C130827E04
OK
(a) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
O5-4 (SGD4) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
O5-6 (SVC4) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
O5-10 (SIG4) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE
RH
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
7
RS–221
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Connect the connectors to the occupant classification
ECU and the rear occupant classification sensor RH.
(b) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-182).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor.
(e) Turn the power switch OFF.
(f) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(g) Check the DTCs (see page RS-182).
OK:
DTC B1783 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1783 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
NG
8
REPLACE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Replace the occupant classification ECU.
HINT:
Perform the inspection using parts from a normal vehicle
if possible.
NEXT
9
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Using the intelligent tester, perform the zero point
calibration (see page RS-174).
OK:
COMPLETED is displayed.
NG
OK
Go to step 12
RS
RS–222
10
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform the sensitivity check
(see page RS-174).
Standard values:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
RS
NG
Go to step 12
OK
11
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-182).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor.
(d) Turn the power switch OFF.
(e) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(f) Check the DTCs (see page RS-182).
OK:
DTC B1783 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1783 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
END
NG
12
REPLACE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Replace the front seat RH (see page SE-1).
NEXT
13
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Using the intelligent tester, perform the zero point
calibration (see page RS-174).
OK:
COMPLETED is displayed.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–223
NEXT
14
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform the sensitivity check
(see page RS-174).
Standard values:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NEXT
END
RS
RS–224
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
DTC
B1785
Front Occupant Classification Sensor LH Collision Detection
DESCRIPTION
RS
DTC B1785 is output when the occupant classification ECU receives a collision detection signal sent by
the front occupant classification sensor LH when an accident occurs.
DTC B1785 is also output when the front seat RH is subjected to a strong impact, even if an actual
accident does not occur.
However, when the occupant classification ECU outputs a collision detection signal, even if the vehicle is
not in a collision, DTC B1785 can be cleared by performing the zero point calibration and sensitivity
check.
Therefore, when DTC B1785 is output, first perform the zero point calibration and sensitivity check.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
When one of following conditions is met:
• Front seat RH malfunction
• Occupant classification ECU malfunction
• Front occupant classification sensor LH detects
large load
B1785
Trouble Area
•
•
Occupant classification ECU
Front seat RH (Front occupant classification sensor
LH)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Front Occupant Classification
Sensor LH
Occupant Classification ECU
SVC1
SVC1
SIG1
SIG1
SGD1
SGD1
C128670E09
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–225
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Using the intelligent tester, perform the zero point
calibration (see page RS-174).
OK:
COMPLETED is displayed.
NG
Go to step 4
OK
2
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform the sensitivity check
(see page RS-174).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NG
Go to step 4
OK
3
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-182).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor.
(c) Turn the power switch OFF.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(e) Check the DTCs (see page RS-182).
OK:
DTC B1785 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1785 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
NG
4
REPLACE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
RS
RS–226
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
(c) Replace the front seat RH (see page SE-1).
HINT:
Perform the inspection using parts from a normal vehicle
if possible.
NEXT
RS
5
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Using the intelligent tester, perform the zero point
calibration (see page RS-174).
OK:
COMPLETED is displayed.
NG
Go to step 8
OK
6
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform the sensitivity check
(see page RS-174).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NG
Go to step 8
OK
7
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-182).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor.
(c) Turn the power switch OFF.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(e) Check the DTCs (see page RS-182).
OK:
DTC B1785 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1785 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
NG
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
8
RS–227
REPLACE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Replace the occupant classification ECU.
NEXT
9
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Using the intelligent tester, perform the zero point
calibration (see page RS-174).
OK:
COMPLETED is displayed.
NEXT
10
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform the sensitivity check
(see page RS-174).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NEXT
END
RS
RS–228
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
DTC
B1786
Front Occupant Classification Sensor RH Collision Detection
DESCRIPTION
RS
DTC B1786 is output when the occupant classification ECU receives a collision detection signal sent by
the front occupant classification sensor RH when an accident occurs.
DTC B1786 is also output when the front seat RH is subjected to a strong impact, even if an actual
accident does not occur.
However, when the occupant classification ECU outputs a collision detection signal, even if the vehicle is
not in a collision, DTC B1786 can be cleared by performing the zero point calibration and sensitivity
check.
Therefore, when DTC B1786 is output, first perform the zero point calibration and sensitivity check.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
When one of following conditions is met:
• Front seat RH malfunction
• Occupant classification ECU malfunction
• Front occupant classification sensor RH detects
large load
B1786
Trouble Area
•
•
Occupant classification ECU
Front seat RH (Front occupant classification sensor
RH)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Front Occupant Classification
Sensor RH
Occupant Classification ECU
SVC2
SVC2
SIG2
SIG2
SGD2
SGD2
C128670E10
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–229
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Using the intelligent tester, perform the zero point
calibration (see page RS-174).
OK:
COMPLETED is displayed.
NG
Go to step 4
OK
2
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform the sensitivity check
(see page RS-174).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NG
Go to step 4
OK
3
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-182).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor.
(c) Turn the power switch OFF.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(e) Check the DTCs (see page RS-182).
OK:
DTC B1786 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1786 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
NG
4
REPLACE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Replace the front seat RH (see page SE-1).
RS
RS–230
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
HINT:
Perform the inspection using parts from a normal vehicle
if possible.
NEXT
RS
5
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Using the intelligent tester, perform the zero point
calibration (see page RS-174).
OK:
COMPLETED is displayed.
NG
Go to step 8
OK
6
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform the sensitivity check
(see page RS-174).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NG
Go to step 8
OK
7
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-182).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor.
(c) Turn the power switch OFF.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(e) Check the DTCs (see page RS-182).
OK:
DTC B1786 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1786 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
NG
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
8
RS–231
REPLACE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Replace the occupant classification ECU.
NEXT
9
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Using the intelligent tester, perform the zero point
calibration (see page RS-174).
OK:
COMPLETED is displayed.
NEXT
10
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform the sensitivity check
(see page RS-174).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NEXT
END
RS
RS–232
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
DTC
B1787
Rear Occupant Classification Sensor LH Collision Detection
DESCRIPTION
RS
DTC B1787 is output when the occupant classification ECU receives a collision detection signal sent by
the rear occupant classification sensor LH when an accident occurs.
DTC B1787 is also output when the front seat RH is subjected to a strong impact, even if an actual
accident does not occur.
However, when the occupant classification ECU outputs a collision detection signal, even if the vehicle is
not in a collision, DTC B1787 can be cleared by performing the zero point calibration and sensitivity
check.
Therefore, when DTC B1787 is output, first perform the zero point calibration and sensitivity check.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
When one of following conditions is met:
• Front seat RH malfunction
• Occupant classification ECU malfunction
• Rear occupant classification sensor LH detects
large load
B1787
Trouble Area
•
•
Occupant classification ECU
Front seat RH (Rear occupant classification sensor
LH)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Rear Occupant Classification
Sensor LH
Occupant Classification ECU
SVC3
SVC3
SIG3
SIG3
SGD3
SGD3
C128670E11
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–233
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Using the intelligent tester, perform the zero point
calibration (see page RS-174).
OK:
COMPLETED is displayed.
NG
Go to step 4
OK
2
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform the sensitivity check
(see page RS-174).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NG
Go to step 4
OK
3
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-182).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor.
(c) Turn the power switch OFF.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(e) Check the DTCs (see page RS-182).
OK:
DTC B1787 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1787 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
NG
4
REPLACE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Replace the front seat RH (see page SE-1).
RS
RS–234
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
HINT:
Perform the inspection using parts from a normal vehicle
if possible.
NEXT
RS
5
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Using the intelligent tester, perform the zero point
calibration (see page RS-174).
OK:
COMPLETED is displayed.
NG
Go to step 8
OK
6
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform the sensitivity check
(see page RS-174).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NG
Go to step 8
OK
7
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-182).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor.
(c) Turn the power switch OFF.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(e) Check the DTCs (see page RS-182).
OK:
DTC B1787 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1787 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
NG
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
8
RS–235
REPLACE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Replace the occupant classification ECU (see page ).
NEXT
9
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Using the intelligent tester, perform the zero point
calibration (see page RS-174).
OK:
COMPLETED is displayed.
NEXT
10
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform the sensitivity check
(see page RS-174).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NEXT
END
RS
RS–236
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
DTC
B1788
Rear Occupant Classification Sensor RH Collision Detection
DESCRIPTION
RS
DTC B1788 is output when the occupant classification ECU receives a collision detection signal sent by
the rear occupant classification sensor RH when an accident occurs.
DTC B1788 is also output when the front seat RH is subjected to a strong impact, even if an actual
accident does not occur.
However, when the occupant classification ECU outputs a collision detection signal, even if the vehicle is
not in a collision, DTC B1788 can be cleared by performing the zero point calibration and sensitivity
check.
Therefore, when DTC B1788 is output, first perform the zero point calibration and sensitivity check.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
When one of following conditions is met:
• Front seat RH malfunction
• Occupant classification ECU malfunction
• Rear occupant classification sensor RH detects
large load
B1788
Trouble Area
•
•
Occupant classification ECU
Front seat RH (Rear occupant classification sensor
RH)
WIRING DIAGRAM
Rear Occupant Classification
Sensor RH
Occupant Classification ECU
SVC4
SVC4
SIG4
SIG4
SGD4
SGD4
C128670E12
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–237
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Using the intelligent tester, perform the zero point
calibration (see page RS-174).
OK:
COMPLETED is displayed.
NG
Go to step 4
OK
2
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform the sensitivity check
(see page RS-174).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NG
Go to step 4
OK
3
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-182).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor.
(c) Turn the power switch OFF.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(e) Check the DTCs (see page RS-182).
OK:
DTC B1788 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1788 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
NG
4
REPLACE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Replace the front seat RH (see page SE-1).
RS
RS–238
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
HINT:
Perform the inspection using parts from a normal vehicle
if possible.
NEXT
RS
5
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Using the intelligent tester, perform the zero point
calibration (see page RS-174).
OK:
COMPLETED is displayed.
NG
Go to step 8
OK
6
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform the sensitivity check
(see page RS-174).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NG
Go to step 8
OK
7
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-182).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor.
(c) Turn the power switch OFF.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(e) Check the DTCs (see page RS-182).
OK:
DTC B1788 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1788 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
NG
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
8
RS–239
REPLACE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Replace the occupant classification ECU.
NEXT
9
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Using the intelligent tester, perform the zero point
calibration (see page RS-174).
OK:
COMPLETED is displayed.
NEXT
10
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform the sensitivity check
(see page RS-174).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NEXT
END
RS
RS–240
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
DTC
B1790
Center Airbag Sensor Assembly Communication Circuit Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
RS
The center airbag sensor communication circuit consists of the occupant classification ECU and the
center airbag sensor.
DTC B1790 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the center airbag sensor communication circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
B1790
When one of following conditions is met:
• Occupant classification ECU detects line short
signal, open signal, short to ground signal or short
circuit to B+ signal in the center airbag sensor
communication circuit for 2 seconds
• Center airbag sensor malfunction
• Occupant classification ECU malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Floor wire
Occupant classification ECU
Center airbag sensor
WIRING DIAGRAM
Occupant Classification ECU
Center Airbag Sensor
FSR+
FSP+
FSR-
FSP-
C123527E03
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–241
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• If troubleshooting (wire harness inspection) is difficult to perform, remove the front passenger seat
installation bolts to see the undersurface of the seat cushion.
• In the above case, hold the seat so that it does not tip over. Holding the seat for a long period of time
may cause a problem, such as seat rail deformation. Hold the seat up only for as long as necessary.
1
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-182).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor.
(c) Turn the power switch OFF.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(e) Check the DTCs (see page RS-182).
OK:
DTC B1790 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1790 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
NG
2
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTOR
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Check that the connectors are properly connected to the
occupant classification ECU and the center airbag
sensor.
OK:
The connectors are properly connected.
NG
OK
CONNECT CONNECTOR
RS
RS–242
3
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (TO B+)
Floor Wire
RS
C
B
D
A
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Occupant
Classification
ECU
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the occupant
classification ECU and the center airbag sensor.
(b) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
O4-8 (FSR+) - Body ground
Below 1 V
O4-4 (FSR-) - Body ground
Below 1 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
Connector C
O4
FSR-
FSR+
H100922E06
OK
4
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (OPEN)
Floor Wire
C
B
A
D
Center Airbag
Sensor
Occupant
Classification
ECU
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Using a service wire, connect terminals A19-16 (FSP+)
and A19-24 (FSP-) of connector B.
NOTICE:
Do not forcibly insert a service wire into the
terminals of the connector when connecting them.
(d) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Connector B
Connector C
A19
O4
FSR+
NG
FSR-
FSP-
FSP+
Service Wire
C130815E01
OK
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
O4-8 (FSR+) - O4-4 (FSR-)
Below 1 Ω
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
5
RS–243
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (SHORT)
(a) Disconnect the service wire from connector B.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Floor Wire
C
B
D
A
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Occupant
Classification
ECU
NG
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
O4-8 (FSR+) - O4-4 (FSR-)
1 MΩ or higher
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
Connector C
O4
FSR-
FSR+
H100922E06
OK
6
CHECK FLOOR WIRE (TO GROUND)
(a) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Floor Wire
C
B
D
A
Center Airbag
Sensor Assembly
Occupant
Classification
ECU
Specified Condition
1 MΩ or higher
O4-4 (FSR-) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
NG
Connector C
O4
FSR-
FSR+
H100922E06
OK
Tester Connection
O4-8 (FSR+) - Body ground
REPAIR OR REPLACE FLOOR WIRE
RS
RS–244
7
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Connect the connectors to the occupant classification
ECU and the center airbag sensor.
(b) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-182).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor.
(e) Turn the power switch OFF.
(f) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(g) Check the DTCs (see page RS-182).
OK:
DTC B1790 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1790 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
RS
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
NG
8
REPLACE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Replace the occupant classification ECU.
HINT:
Perform the inspection using parts from a normal vehicle
if possible.
NEXT
9
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) terminal battery,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Using the intelligent tester, perform the zero point
calibration (see page RS-174).
OK:
COMPLETED is displayed.
NEXT
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
10
RS–245
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform the sensitivity check
(see page RS-174).
Standard values:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NEXT
11
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-182).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor.
(c) Turn the power switch OFF.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(e) Check the DTCs (see page RS-182).
OK:
DTC B1790 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1790 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
NG
OK
END
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
RS
RS–246
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
DTC
B1793
Occupant Classification Sensor Power Supply
Circuit Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
RS
The occupant classification sensor power supply circuit consists of the occupant classification ECU and
the occupant classification sensors.
DTC B1793 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the occupant classification sensor power
supply circuit.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
B1793
When one of following conditions is met:
• Occupant classification ECU detects line short
signal, open signal, short to ground signal or short
to B+ signal in the occupant classification sensor
power supply circuit for 2 seconds
• Occupant classification ECU malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Front seat wire RH
Front seat RH (Occupant classification sensors)
Occupant classification ECU
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–247
WIRING DIAGRAM
Front Occupant Classification Sensor LH
Occupant Classification
ECU
RS
SVC1
SVC1
Front Occupant Classification Sensor RH
SVC2
SVC2
Rear Occupant Classification Sensor LH
SVC3
SVC3
Rear Occupant Classification Sensor RH
SVC4
SVC4
C128672E03
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
HINT:
• If troubleshooting (wire harness inspection) is difficult to perform, remove the front passenger seat
installation bolts to see the undersurface of the seat cushion.
• In the above case, hold the seat so that it does not tip over. Holding the seat for a long period of time
may cause a problem, such as seat rail deformation. Hold the seat up only for as long as necessary.
1
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-182).
RS–248
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor.
(c) Turn the power switch OFF.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(e) Check the DTCs (see page RS-182).
OK:
DTC B1793 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1793 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
RS
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
NG
2
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTOR
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Check that the connectors are properly connected to the
occupant classification ECU and the occupant
classification sensors.
OK:
The connectors are properly connected.
NG
CONNECT CONNECTOR
OK
3
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH (TO B+)
O5
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the occupant
classification ECU and the 4 occupant classification
sensors.
(b) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
SVC3
SVC4
SVC2
SVC1
H043111E43
Specified Condition
O5-11 (SVC1) - Body ground
Below 1 V
O5-12 (SVC2) - Body ground
Below 1 V
O5-5 (SVC3) - Body ground
Below 1 V
O5-6 (SVC4) - Body ground
Below 1 V
NG
OK
Tester Connection
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE
RH
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
4
RS–249
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH (TO GROUND)
O5
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
SVC3
SVC4
SVC2
Tester Connection
SVC1
Specified Condition
O5-11 (SVC1) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
O5-12 (SVC2) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
H043111E43
O5-5 (SVC3) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
O5-6 (SVC4) - Body ground
1 MΩ or higher
NG
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE
RH
RS
RS–250
5
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH (OPEN)
(a) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Front Seat Wire RH
RS
C
B
D
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
O5-11 (SVC1) - O6-1 (SVC1)
Below 1 Ω
O5-12 (SVC2) - O7-1 (SVC2)
Below 1 Ω
O5-5 (SVC3) - O8-1 (SVC3)
Below 1 Ω
O5-6 (SVC4) - O9-1 (SVC4)
Below 1 Ω
A
Occupant
Classification
ECU
Occupant Classification
Sensor
Connector C
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE
RH
Front LH
O6
SVC1
Front RH
O7
SVC2
Rear LH
Connector B
SVC3
O5
SVC4
O8
SVC2
SVC3
SVC1
Rear RH
O9
SVC4
H100925E04
OK
6
CHECK FRONT SEAT WIRE RH (SHORT)
O5
(a) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
SVC3
SVC4
SVC2
SVC1
H043111E43
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
O5-5 (SVC3) - O5-6 (SVC4)
1 MΩ or higher
O5-6 (SVC4) - O5-11 (SVC1)
1 MΩ or higher
O5-11 (SVC1) - O5-12 (SVC2)
1 MΩ or higher
O5-12 (SVC2) - O5-5 (SVC3)
1 MΩ or higher
O5-12 (SVC2) - O5-6 (SVC4)
1 MΩ or higher
O5-11 (SVC1) - O5-5 (SVC3)
1 MΩ or higher
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
NG
RS–251
REPAIR OR REPLACE FRONT SEAT WIRE
RH
OK
7
RS
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Connect the connectors to the occupant classification
ECU and the 4 occupant classification sensors.
(b) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-182).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor.
(e) Turn the power switch OFF.
(f) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(g) Check the DTCs (see page RS-182).
OK:
DTC B1793 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1793 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
NG
8
REPLACE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Replace the occupant classification ECU.
HINT:
Perform the inspection using parts from a normal vehicle
if possible.
NEXT
9
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Using the intelligent tester, perform the zero point
calibration (see page RS-174).
OK:
COMPLETED is displayed.
NG
Go to step 12
RS–252
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
OK
10
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform the sensitivity check
(see page RS-174).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
RS
NG
Go to step 12
OK
11
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-182).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor.
(d) Turn the power switch OFF.
(e) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(f) Check the DTCs (see page RS-182).
OK:
DTC B1793 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1793 may be output at this time,
but they are related to this check.
OK
END
NG
12
REPLACE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Replace the front seat RH (see page SE-1).
NEXT
13
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Using the intelligent tester, perform the zero point
calibration (see page RS-174).
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–253
OK:
COMPLETED is displayed.
NEXT
14
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
RS
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform the sensitivity check
(see page RS-174).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NEXT
END
RS–254
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
DTC
Open in Occupant Classification ECU Battery
Positive Line
B1794
DESCRIPTION
RS
DTC B1794 is set when a malfunction is detected in the occupant classification ECU battery positive line.
DTC No.
B1794
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
When one of following conditions is met:
• Occupant classification ECU circuit malfunction
• Occupant classification ECU malfunction
• Occupant classification ECU detects short to
ground signal in passenger side buckle switch
circuit for 2 seconds
•
•
Wire harness
Occupant classification ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
Occupant Classification ECU
from DOME Fuse
ECU-B
+B
from IG1 Relay
ECU-IG
IG
GND
C130828E01
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–255
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-182).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor.
(c) Turn the power switch OFF, and wait for at least 10
seconds.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(e) Check the DTCs (see page RS-182).
OK:
DTC B1794 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than B1794 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
NG
2
CHECK CONNECTION OF CONNECTOR
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Check that the connectors are properly connected to the
occupant classification ECU.
OK:
The connectors are properly connected.
NG
CONNECT CONNECTOR
OK
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SOURCE VOLTAGE)
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the O4 connector from the occupant
classification ECU.
(d) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(e) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
O4
GND
+B
IG
H043112E15
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
O4-1 (+B) - Body
ground
Always
10 to 14 V
O4-7 (IG) - Body ground
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
RS
RS–256
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
(f)
RS
Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
O4-3 (GND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR (BATTERY - OCCUPANT
CLASSIFICATION ECU)
OK
4
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Connect the connectors to the occupant classification
ECU.
(d) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(e) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(f) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-182).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor.
(g) Turn the power switch OFF, and wait for at least 10
seconds.
(h) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(i) Using the intelligent tester, check for DTCs of the
occupant classification ECU (see page RS-182).
OK:
DTC B1794 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than B1794 may be output at this time, but
they are not related to this check.
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
NG
5
REPLACE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Replace the occupant classification ECU.
HINT:
Perform the inspection using parts from a normal vehicle
when possible.
NEXT
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
6
RS–257
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Using the intelligent tester, perform the zero point
calibration (see page RS-174).
OK:
COMPLETED is displayed
NEXT
7
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform the sensitivity check
(see page RS-174).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NEXT
END
RS
RS–258
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
DTC
B1795
Occupant Classification ECU Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
RS
DTC B1795 is recorded when a malfunction is detected in the occupant classification ECU.
Troubleshoot DTC B1771 first when DTC B1771 and B1795 are output simultaneously.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
B1795
When one of following conditions is met:
• The occupant classification ECU receives the
power switch OFF to ON (IG) signal 50 times in a
row when a malfunction occurs in the power circuit
for the occupant classification ECU (OFF to ON
(IG) to OFF should be counted as 1 time).
• Occupant classification ECU circuit malfunction
• The occupant classification ECU receives a short to
ground signal in the passenger side buckle switch
circuit for 2 seconds.
• Occupant classification ECU malfunction
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
•
Battery
ECU-B fuse
No. 2 floor wire
Front seat inner belt RH
Occupant classification ECU
WIRING DIAGRAM
Occupant Classification ECU
from DOME Fuse
ECU-B
+B
from IG1 Relay
ECU-IG
IG
GND
C130828E01
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–259
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 10
seconds.
(b) Check the DTCs (see page RS-182).
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC B1795 is output.
A
DTC B1771 and B1795 are output.
B
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1771 and B1795 may be output
at this time, but they are not related to this check.
B
GO TO DTC B1771
A
2
CHECK FUSE (ECU-B)
(a) Check the ECU-B fuse from the instrument panel
junction block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the fuse.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE FUSE
OK
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (SOURCE VOLTAGE)
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Disconnect the No. 2 floor wire connector from the
occupant classification ECU.
(d) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(e) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
O4
GND
+B
IG
H043112E16
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
O4-1 (+B) - Body
ground
Always
10 to 14 V
O4-7 (IG) - Body ground
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
(f) Turn the power switch OFF.
(g) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
RS
RS–260
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
O4-3 (GND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
RS
REPAIR OR REPLACE WIRE HARNESS
OK
4
REPLACE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Replace the occupant classification ECU.
HINT:
Perform the inspection using parts from a normal vehicle
if possible.
NEXT
5
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Using the intelligent tester, perform the zero point
calibration (see page RS-174).
OK:
COMPLETED is displayed.
NEXT
6
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform the sensitivity check
(see page RS-174).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NEXT
END
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
DTC
RS–261
Sleep Operation Failure of Occupant Classification ECU
B1796
DESCRIPTION
During sleep mode, the occupant classification ECU reads the condition of each sensor while the power
switch is OFF.
In this mode, if the occupant classification ECU detects an internal malfunction, DTC B1796 is output.
DTC No.
B1796
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
Occupant classification ECU malfunction
Occupant classification ECU
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-182).
HINT:
First clear DTCs stored in the occupant classification
ECU and then in the center airbag sensor.
(c) Turn the power switch OFF, and wait for at least 2
seconds.
(d) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(e) Check the DTCs (see page RS-182).
OK:
DTC B1796 is not output.
HINT:
DTCs other than DTC B1796 may be output at this time,
but they are not related to this check.
OK
USE SIMULATION METHOD TO CHECK
NG
2
REPLACE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Replace the occupant classification ECU.
HINT:
Perform the inspection using parts from a normal vehicle
if possible.
NEXT
3
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester to the DLC3.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
RS
RS–262
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
(d) Using the intelligent tester, perform the zero point
calibration (see page RS-174).
OK:
COMPLETED is displayed.
NEXT
RS
4
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform the sensitivity check
(see page RS-174).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NEXT
END
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–263
Trouble in Passenger Airbag ON / OFF Indicator
DESCRIPTION
The occupant classification system detects the front passenger seat condition and then indicates whether
the front passenger airbag is activated or not through the passenger airbag ON / OFF indicator
illumination.
The passenger airbag ON / OFF indicator illumination changes depending on the front passenger seat
condition as shown in the table below.
Front Passenger Seat Condition
ON Indicator
OFF Indicator
Adult is seated
ON
OFF
Child is seated
OFF
ON
Vacant
OFF
OFF
Occupant classification system failure
OFF
ON
RS
RS–264
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Center Airbag Sensor
Passenger Airbag ON/OFF Indicator
RS
PAON
PAON
P-AB
P-AB
Occupant Classification ECU
FSR+
FSP+
FSR-
FSP-
SIG1
SIG1
SVC1
SVC1
SGD1
SGD1
Front Occupant Classification Sensor LH
SIG2
SIG2
SVC2
SVC2
SGD2
SGD2
Front Occupant Classification Sensor RH
SIG3
SIG3
SVC3
SVC3
SGD3
SGD3
Rear Occupant Classification Sensor LH
SIG4
SIG4
SVC4
SVC4
SGD4
SGD4
Rear Occupant Classification Sensor RH
C128675E04
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–265
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK SRS WARNING LIGHT
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and check the SRS
warning light condition.
OK:
The SRS warning light does not come on.
NG
Go to step 9
OK
2
CHECK PASSENGER AIRBAG ON/OFF INDICATOR CONDITION
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Check if the passenger airbag ON/OFF indicator
correctly indicates the front passenger seat condition.
OK
Front Passenger Seat Condition
ON Indicator
OFF Indicator
Adult is seated
ON
OFF
Child is seated
OFF
ON
Vacant
OFF
OFF
Occupant classification system failure
OFF
ON
OK
END
NG
3
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Using the intelligent tester, perform the zero point
calibration (see page RS-174).
OK:
COMPLETED is displayed.
NG
Go to step 5
OK
4
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform the sensitivity check
(see page RS-174).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NG
Go to step 5
RS
RS–266
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
OK
END
RS
5
RETIGHTEN FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY RH BOLT
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Loosen the 4 installation bolts of the front seat RH.
(c) Tighten the 4 installation bolts of the front seat RH to the
specified torque (see page SE-1).
Torque:
37 N*m{ 380 kgf*cm , 27 ft.*lbf }
NG
Go to step 8
OK
6
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Using the intelligent tester, perform the zero point
calibration (see page RS-174).
OK:
COMPLETED is displayed.
NG
Go to step 8
OK
7
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform the sensitivity check
(see page RS-174).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NG
Go to step 8
OK
8
CHECK CONNECTOR
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Check that the connectors are properly connected to the
occupant classification ECU and the 4 occupant
classification sensors.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
RS–267
OK:
The connectors are connected.
(d) Disconnect the connectors from the occupant
classification ECU and the 4 occupant classification
sensors.
(e) Check that the connectors are not damaged or
deformed.
OK:
The connectors are normal.
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE WIRE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
9
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Connect the connectors to the occupant classification
ECU and the 4 occupant classification sensors.
(b) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(d) Turn the power switch OFF.
(e) Clear the DTCs (see page RS-182).
(f) Turn the power switch ON (IG), and wait for at least 60
seconds.
(g) Check the DTCs (see page RS-182).
OK:
DTC is not output.
NG
REPLACE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR
ASSEMBLY
OK
10
REPLACE OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION ECU
(a) Turn the power switch OFF.
(b) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal, and wait for at least 90 seconds.
(c) Replace the occupant classification ECU (see page RS182).
HINT:
Perform the inspection using parts from a normal vehicle
if possible.
NEXT
11
PERFORM ZERO POINT CALIBRATION
(a) Connect the cable to the negative (-) battery terminal,
and wait for at least 2 seconds.
RS
RS–268
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – OCCUPANT CLASSIFICATION SYSTEM
(b) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Using the intelligent tester, perform the zero point
calibration (see page RS-174).
OK:
COMPLETED is displayed.
RS
NEXT
12
PERFORM SENSITIVITY CHECK
(a) Using the intelligent tester, perform the sensitivity check
(see page RS-174).
Standard value:
27 to 33 kg (59.52 to 72.75 lb)
NEXT
END
RS–266
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – STEERING PAD
STEERING PAD
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
RESTRAINTS
COMPONENTS
RS
“TORX” SCREW
“TORX” SCREW
8.8 (90, 78 in.*lbf)
8.8 (90, 78 in.*lbf)
50 (510, 37)
NO. 2 STEERING
COLUMN COVER LOWER
STEERING WHEEL ASSEMBLY
NO. 3 STEERING COLUMN
COVER LOWER
STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
)
B126629E02
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – STEERING PAD
RS–267
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
H043732E02
2.
H043733E02
Contact Plate
H043734E03
H043735E02
CHECK STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY (VEHICLE NOT
INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG NOT
DEPLOYED)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (see page RS41).
(b) With the steering pad (with airbag) installed on the
vehicle, perform a visual check:
Check for cuts, cracks or discoloration on the
steering pad outer surface and in the grooved
portion.
If any of the defects mentioned above are present,
replace the steering pad assembly with a new one.
CAUTION:
For removal and installation of the steering pad
assembly, be sure to follow the correct
procedures.
CHECK STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY (VEHICLE
INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG NOT
DEPLOYED)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (see page RS41).
(b) With the steering pad (with airbag) removed from
the vehicle, perform a visual check:
• Check for cuts, cracks or discoloration on the
steering pad outer surface and in the grooved
portion.
• Check for cuts and cracks in the wire harness,
and chipping on the connectors.
• Check for deformation on the steering wheel.
• Check for deformation of the steering pad
contact plates.
If any of the defects mentioned above are present,
replace the steering pad assembly with a new one.
CAUTION:
For removal and installation of the steering pad
assembly, be sure to follow the correct
procedures.
HINT:
• If the steering pad contact plates are deformed,
never repair them. Always replace the steering
pad assembly with a new one.
• There should be no interference between the
steering pad and steering wheel, and the
clearance should be uniform all the way around
when the new steering pad is installed on the
steering wheel.
RS
RS–268
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – STEERING PAD
REMOVAL
CAUTION:
Be sure to read the precautionary notices concerning the
SRS airbag system before servicing it (see page RS-1).
RS
Screw
Case
Torx
Screw
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE NO. 2 STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER
3.
REMOVE NO. 3 STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER
4.
REMOVE STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY
(a) Straighten the front wheels.
(b) Using a T30 "torx" socket, loosen the 2 screws until
the groove along each screw circumference catches
on the screw case.
No. 2 Steering Wheel
No. 3 Steering Wheel Cover Lower
Cover Lower
A125170E03
H043738E02
(c) Pull out the steering pad from the steering wheel
and support the steering pad with one hand as
shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
When removing the steering pad, do not pull the
airbag wire harness.
(d) Using a screwdriver, disconnect the 2 airbag
connectors.
CAUTION:
When handling the airbag connector, do not
damage the airbag wire harness.
(e) Disconnect the horn connector and remove the
steering pad.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – STEERING PAD
RS–269
INSTALLATION
CAUTION:
Be sure to read the precautionary notices concerning the
SRS airbag system before servicing it (see page RS-1).
1.
INSTALL STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY
(a) Support the steering pad with one hand as shown in
the illustration.
(b) Connect the 2 airbag connectors.
NOTICE:
When handling the airbag connector, do not
damage the airbag wire harness.
(c) Connect the horn connector.
(d) Install the steering pad after confirming that the
circumference grooves of the screws are caught on
the screw case.
(e) Using a T30 "torx" socket, install the 2 screws.
Torque: 8.8 N*m (90 kgf*cm, 78 in.*lbf)
2.
INSTALL NO. 2 STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER
3.
INSTALL NO. 3 STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER
4.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
5.
INSPECT STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY
(a) Check for cuts, cracks or discoloration on the
steering pad outer surface and in the grooved
portion.
(b) Check that the horn sounds.
6.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
7.
CHECK SRS WARNING LIGHT
(a) Check the SRS warning light (see page RS-31).
H043738E03
RS
RS–270
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – STEERING PAD
DISPOSAL
RS
SST
C110371E03
HINT:
When scrapping a vehicle equipped with an SRS or disposing
of the steering pad, be sure to deploy the airbag first in
accordance with the procedure described below. If any
abnormality occurs with the airbag deployment, contact the
SERVICE DEPARTMENT of TOYOTA MOTOR SALES,
U.S.A., INC.
CAUTION:
• Never dispose of a steering pad with an unactivated
airbag.
• The airbag produces a loud, exploding sound when it
activates. Perform the operation where it will not be a
nuisance to people nearby.
• When activating the airbag, always use the specified
SST (SRS airbag deployment tool).
• Perform procedures in a place away from electrical
interference.
• When activating the airbag, stand at least 10 m (33 ft.)
away from the steering pad.
• The steering pad becomes very hot when the airbag is
deployed. Do not touch it for at least 30 minutes after
activation.
• Use gloves and safety glasses when handling a
steering pad with a deployed airbag.
• Do not apply water to a steering pad with a deployed
airbag.
• Always wash your hands with water after completing
the operation.
1.
DISPOSE OF STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY
TOGETHER WITH VEHICLE
HINT:
Prepare a battery as the power source to deploy the
airbag.
(a) Check if SST is functioning properly.
SST 09082-00700
SST
C110371E03
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – STEERING PAD
Battery
SST
RS–271
(1) Connect the SST's red clip to the positive (+)
battery terminal and the black clip to the
negative (-) battery terminal.
HINT:
The yellow connector will be used to connect to
another SST in a later step.
C110372E03
SST
C110475E02
(2) Press the SST activation switch, and check that
the LED of the SST activation switch
illuminates.
CAUTION:
If the LED illuminates when the activation
switch is not pressed, SST may have a
malfunction, in which case that SST should
not be used.
(3) Disconnect SST from the battery.
(b) Follow the "Precaution" (see page RS-1).
(c) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal.
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner
activation.
(d) Remove the steering column cover lower.
(1) Turn the steering wheel to the right and left as
necessary to remove the 2 screws.
(2) Remove the screw and cover lower.
H043739E02
SST (B)
SST (A)
H043740E02
(e) Install SST.
CAUTION:
Check that there is no free play in the steering
wheel and steering pad.
(1) Disconnect the yellow airbag connector from
the spiral cable.
NOTICE:
When handling the airbag connector, do not
damage the airbag wire harness.
(2) Connect SST (A) to SST (B). Then connect the
SST (B)'s connector to the spiral cable.
SST 09082-00700, 09082-00780
RS
RS–272
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – STEERING PAD
NOTICE:
To avoid damaging the SST connector and
wire harness, do not lock the secondary
lock of the twin lock.
RS
Battery
SST
10 m or more
C110476E02
(f)
2.
(3) Move SST at least 10 m (33 ft.) away from the
front side window.
(4) Maintain a small opening in the front side
window for the SST wire harness. Close the
remaining windows of the vehicle. Close all
doors.
NOTICE:
Take care not do damage the SST wire
harness.
(5) Connect the SST's red clip to the positive (+)
battery terminal and the black clip to the
negative (-) battery terminal.
Deploy the airbag.
(1) Check that no one is inside the vehicle or within
a 10 m (33 ft.) radius of the vehicle.
(2) Press the SST activation switch and deploy the
airbag.
CAUTION:
• When deploying the airbag, make sure
that no one is near the vehicle.
• The steering pad becomes extremely hot
when the airbag is deployed. Do not
touch it for at least 30 minutes after
deployment.
• Use gloves and safety glasses when
handling a steering pad with a deployed
airbag.
• Do not apply water to a steering pad with
a deployed airbag.
• Always wash your hands with water after
completing the operation.
HINT:
The airbag is deployed as the SST activation
switch LED illuminates.
DISPOSE OF ONLY STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY
NOTICE:
• When disposing of the steering pad, never use the
customer's vehicle to deploy the airbag.
• Be sure to follow the procedure detailed below
when deploying the airbag.
HINT:
Prepare a battery as the power source to deploy the
airbag.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – STEERING PAD
SST
B104819E02
A
Stripped Wire Harness Section
B104882E06
L
M
H043742E03
RS–273
(a) Check if SST is functioning properly (see previous
step).
(b) Remove the steering pad (see page RS-267).
CAUTION:
• When removing the steering pad, work must
be started at least 90 seconds after the
ignition switch is turned OFF and the cable is
disconnected from the negative (-) battery
terminal.
• When storing the steering pad, keep the
airbag deployment side facing upward.
(c) Using service wire harnesses for the vehicle, tie
down the steering pad to a disc wheel (with tire).
Wire harness:
Stripped wire harness section A:
1.25 mm2 or more (0.0019 in.2 or more)
NOTICE:
Use a disc wheel (with tire) that you are planning
to throw away, as the airbag deployment will
damage the disc wheel.
CAUTION:
Do not use wire harnesses that are too thin or
any other substitute items to tie down the
steering pad. They may snap when the airbag
deploys. Always use vehicle wire harnesses that
have an area of at least 1.25 mm2 or more
(0.0019 in.2).
HINT:
To calculate the area of the stripped wire harness
section:
Area = 3.14 x Diameter2/4
(1) Install the 2 bolts with washers into the 2 bolt
holes of the steering pad.
Bolt:
L:
35.0 mm (1.378 in.)
M:
6.0 mm (0.236 in.)
Pitch:
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
NOTICE:
• Tighten the bolts by hand until they
become difficult to turn.
• Do not tighten the bolts excessively.
RS
RS–274
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – STEERING PAD
(2) After connecting SST to each other, connect
them to the steering pad.
SST 09082-00802 (09082-10801, 0908230801)
SST
RS
H043743E03
(3) Wind 3 wire harnesses at least twice around
the bolts installed on the left and right sides of
the steering pad.
CAUTION:
• Tightly wind the wire harnesses around
the bolts so that there is no slack.
• Make sure that the wire harnesses are
tight. If there is slack in a wire harness,
the steering pad may come loose when
the airbag is deployed.
2 Times or more
2 Times or more
H043744E05
H043745E02
(4) Face the airbag deployment side of the
steering pad upward. Separately tie the left and
right sides of the steering pad to a disc wheel
through the hub nut holes. Position the SST
connector so that it hangs downward through
the hub hole in the disc wheel.
CAUTION:
• Make sure that the wire harnesses are
tight. If there is slack in a wire harness,
the steering pad may come loose when
the airbag is deployed.
• Always tie down the steering pad with
the airbag deployment side facing
upward.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – STEERING PAD
(d)
SST
H043746E03
RS–275
Install SST.
CAUTION:
Place the tire with disc wheel and steering pad
on a level surface.
(1) Connect the connector of SST.
SST 09082-00700
NOTICE:
To avoid damaging the SST connector and
wire harness, do not lock the secondary
lock of the twin lock. Also, secure some
slack for the SST wire harness inside the
disc wheel.
(2) Move SST at least 10 m (33 ft.) away from the
steering pad.
Battery
SST
10 m or more
H040014E05
Y
Y
X
Weight
H042015E05
(e) Cover the steering pad with a cardboard box or
tires.
(1) Covering method using a cardboard box:
Cover the steering pad with the cardboard box
and place weights of at least 19 kg (43 lb) on
the cardboard box in 4 places.
Cardboard box size:
X minimum = 460 mm (18.11 in.)
Y minimum = 650 mm (25.59 in.)
NOTICE:
• When dimension Y of the cardboard box
exceeds the tire dimension, X should be
the following size.
X minimum = 460 mm (18.11 in.) +
width of tire
• If using a cardboard box that is smaller
than the specified size, the cardboard
box will break during airbag deployment.
RS
RS–276
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – STEERING PAD
(2) Covering method using tires:
Place at least 3 tires (without disc wheels) on
top of the tire (with disc wheel and steering
pad).
Tire size:
Width minimum:
185 mm (7.28 in.)
Inner diameter minimum:
360 mm (14.17 in.)
CAUTION:
Do not use tires with disc wheels to cover
the tire (with disc wheel and steering pad).
NOTICE:
• Use tires that you are planning to throw
away, as the airbag deployment may
damage the tires.
• Do not place the SST connector under
the tire as the connector may be
damaged.
Inner Diameter
RS
Width
Tires
(3 or more)
A125171E02
(3) Tie the tires together with 2 wire harnesses.
CAUTION:
Make sure that the wire harnesses are tight.
If there is slack in a wire harness, the tires
may come loose when the airbag is
deployed.
H043722E01
(f)
Steering Pad
Battery
SST
10 m or more
B110263E03
Deploy the airbag.
(1) Connect the SST's red clip to the positive (+)
battery terminal and the black clip to the
negative (-) battery terminal.
(2) Check that no one is within a 10 m (33 ft.)
radius of the steering pad.
(3) Press the SST activation switch and deploy the
airbag.
CAUTION:
When deploying the airbag, make sure that
no one is near the tires.
HINT:
The airbag is deployed as the SST activation
switch LED illuminates.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – STEERING PAD
H040177E01
RS–277
(g) Dispose of the steering pad.
CAUTION:
• The steering pad becomes extremely hot
when the airbag is deployed. Do not touch it
for at least 30 minutes after deployment.
• Do not apply water to a steering pad with a
deployed airbag.
• Always wash your hands with water after
completing the operation.
(1) Remove the steering pad from the disc wheel.
(2) Place the steering pad in a plastic bag, tie it
tightly and dispose of it in the same way as
other general parts.
RS
RS–277
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – SPIRAL CABLE
SPIRAL CABLE
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
RESTRAINTS
COMPONENTS
“TORX” SCREW
“TORX” SCREW
8.8 (90, 78 in.*lbf)
8.8 (90, 78 in.*lbf)
STEERING COLUMN COVER (UPPER)
50 (510, 37)
NO. 2 STEERING WHEEL
COVER LOWER
SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSEMBLY
NO. 3 STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER
STEERING COLUMN COVER (LOWER)
STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
)
B126650E02
RS
RS–278
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – SPIRAL CABLE
REMOVAL
CAUTION:
Be sure to read the precautionary notices concerning the
SRS airbag system before servicing it (see page RS-1).
RS
H043749E02
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
PLACE FRONT WHEELS FACING STRAIGHT AHEAD
3.
REMOVE NO. 2 STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER
4.
REMOVE NO. 3 STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER
5.
REMOVE STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY (See page RS268)
6.
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL ASSEMBLY (See page
SR-8)
7.
REMOVE STEERING COLUMN COVER (See page
SR-8)
8.
REMOVE SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the airbag connector.
NOTICE:
When handling the airbag connector, do not
damage the airbag wire harness.
(b) Detach the 3 claws and remove the spiral cable.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – SPIRAL CABLE
RS–279
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Check that there are no scratches or cracks on its
connector, and that the cable does not have cracks,
dents or chipping.
RS
RS–280
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – SPIRAL CABLE
INSTALLATION
CAUTION:
Be sure to read the precautionary notices concerning the
SRS airbag system before servicing it (see page RS-1).
RS
1.
INSTALL SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Check that the front wheels are facing straight
ahead.
(b) Set the turn signal switch to the neutral position.
NOTICE:
Make sure that the turn signal switch is in the
neutral position, as the pin of the turn signal
switch may be snapped.
(c) Install the spiral cable.
NOTICE:
When replacing the spiral cable with a new one,
remove the lock pin before installing the
steering wheel.
(d) Connect the connector to the spiral cable.
NOTICE:
When handling the airbag connector, do not
damage the airbag wire harness.
2.
INSTALL STEERING COLUMN COVER (See page SR14)
3.
POSITION SPIRAL CABLE
(a) Slowly rotate the spiral cable counterclockwise by
hand until it feels firm.
NOTICE:
Do not use the airbag wire harness to turn the
spiral cable.
H043750E02
(b) Rotate the spiral cable clockwise approximately 2.5
turns to align the marks.
NOTICE:
Do not use the airbag wire harness to turn the
spiral cable.
HINT:
The spiral cable will rotate approximately 2.5 turns
to the left and right from the center.
Marks
4.
INSTALL STEERING WHEEL ASSEMBLY (See page
SR-15)
5.
INSTALL STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY (See page RS269)
6.
INSTALL NO. 2 STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER
7.
INSTALL NO. 3 STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER
8.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
H043751E02
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – SPIRAL CABLE
9.
RS–281
INSPECT STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY (See page RS267)
10. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from the
negative (-) battery terminal.
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
11. CHECK SRS WARNING LIGHT
(a) Check the SRS warning light (see page RS-31).
12. INSPECT STEERING WHEEL POSITION
RS
RS–280
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
RESTRAINTS
COMPONENTS
RS
FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
20 (204, 15)
INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE ASSEMBLY
INSTRUMENT PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
)
B126630E02
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
RS–281
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
H043752E02
2.
H043753E02
H043754E02
CHECK FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(VEHICLE NOT INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND
AIRBAG NOT DEPLOYED)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (see page RS41).
(b) With the front passenger airbag installed on the
vehicle, perform a visual check:
Check for cuts, cracks or discoloration on the front
passenger airbag surface and in the grooved
portion.
If any of the defects mentioned above are present,
replace the front passenger airbag with a new one.
CAUTION:
For removal and installation of the front
passenger airbag, be sure to follow the correct
procedures.
CHECK FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(VEHICLE INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG
NOT DEPLOYED)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (see page RS41).
(b) With the front passenger airbag removed from the
vehicle, perform a visual check:
• Check for cuts, cracks or discoloration on the
front passenger airbag.
• Check for cracks or other damage on the
connectors.
• Check for deformation or cracks on the
instrument panel and instrument panel
reinforcement.
If any of the defects mentioned above are present,
replace the front passenger airbag with a new one.
CAUTION:
For removal and installation of the front
passenger airbag, be sure to follow the correct
procedures.
RS
RS–282
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
REMOVAL
CAUTION:
Be sure to read the precautionary notices concerning the
SRS airbag system before servicing it (see page RS-1).
RS
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-7)
3.
DISCONNECT PASSENGER AIRBAG CONNECTOR
(a) Disconnect the front passenger airbag connector.
NOTICE:
When handling the airbag connector, take care
not to damage the airbag wire harness.
4.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
(a) Remove the instrument panel (see page IP-5).
5.
DISCONNECT INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE
ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connectors from the front passenger
airbag.
NOTICE:
When handling the airbag connector, take care
not to damage the airbag wire harness.
6.
REMOVE FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(a) Detach the 10 claws and remove the front
passenger airbag.
H043756E02
H043758E03
)
C130877
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
RS–283
INSTALLATION
CAUTION:
Be sure to read the precautionary notices concerning the
SRS airbag system before servicing it (see page RS-1).
)
1.
INSTALL FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(a) Attach the 10 claws to install the front passenger
airbag.
2.
CONNECT INSTRUMENT PANEL WIRE ASSEMBLY
(a) Connect the connectors to the front passenger
airbag.
NOTICE:
When handling the airbag connector, do not
damage the airbag wire harness.
3.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
(a) Install the instrument panel (see page IP-11).
NOTICE:
When handling the airbag connector, do not
damage the airbag wire harness.
4.
CONNECT PASSENGER AIRBAG CONNECTOR
(a) Connect the front passenger airbag connector.
NOTICE:
When handling the airbag connector, do not
damage the airbag wire harness.
5.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
6.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
7.
CHECK SRS WARNING LIGHT
(a) Check the SRS warning light (see page RS-31).
C130877
H043758E02
H043757E02
RS
RS–284
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
DISPOSAL
RS
SST
C110371E03
HINT:
When scrapping a vehicle equipped with an SRS or disposing
of the front passenger airbag assembly, be sure to deploy the
airbag first in accordance with the procedure described
below. If any abnormality occurs with the airbag deployment,
contact the SERVICE DEPARTMENT of TOYOTA MOTOR
SALES, U.S.A., INC.
CAUTION:
• Never dispose of a front passenger airbag with an
unactivated airbag.
• The airbag produces a loud, exploding sound when it
activates. Perform the operation where it will not be a
nuisance to people nearby.
• When activating the airbag, always use the specified
SST (SRS airbag deployment tool).
• Perform procedures in a place away from electrical
interference.
• When activating the airbag, stand at least 10 m (33 ft.)
away from the airbag.
• The airbag becomes very hot when it is deployed. Do
not touch it for at least 30 minutes after activation.
• Use gloves and safety glasses when handling a
deployed airbag.
• Do not apply water to a deployed airbag.
• Always wash your hands with water after completing
the operation.
1.
DISPOSE OF FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG
ASSEMBLY TOGETHER WITH VEHICLE
HINT:
Prepare a battery as the power source to deploy the
airbag.
(a) Check if SST is functioning properly.
SST 09082-00700
(1) Connect the SST's red clip to the positive (+)
battery terminal and the black clip to the
negative (-) battery terminal.
HINT:
The yellow connector will be used to connect to
another SST in a later step.
SST
C110371E03
SST
C110475E02
(2) Press the SST activation switch, and check that
the LED of the SST activation switch
illuminates.
CAUTION:
If the LED illuminates when the activation
switch is not pressed, SST may have a
malfunction, in which case that SST should
not be used.
(3) Disconnect SST from the battery.
(b) Follow the "Precaution" (see page RS-1).
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
RS–285
(c) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal.
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner
activation.
(d) Remove the glove compartment door (see page IP7).
(e) Install SST.
(1) Disconnect the front passenger airbag
connector.
NOTICE:
When handling the airbag connector, do not
damage the airbag wire harness.
H043756E03
(2) Connect SST (A) to SST (B). Then connect the
SST (B)'s connector to the cable.
SST 09082-00700, 09082-00780
NOTICE:
To avoid damaging the SST connector and
wire harness, do not lock the secondary
lock of the twin lock.
SST(A)
SST(B)
H043760E03
Battery
SST
10 m or more
C110476E02
(f)
(3) Move SST at least 10 m (33 ft.) away from the
front side window.
(4) Maintain a small opening in the front side
window for the SST wire harness. Close the
remaining windows of the vehicle. Close all
doors.
NOTICE:
Take care not to damage the SST wire
harness.
(5) Connect the SST's red clip to the positive (+)
battery terminal and the black clip to the
negative (-) battery terminal.
Deploy the airbag.
(1) Check that no one is inside the vehicle or within
a 10 m (33 ft.) radius of the vehicle.
(2) Press the SST activation switch and deploy the
airbag.
CAUTION:
• When deploying the airbag, make sure
that no one is near the vehicle.
• The airbag becomes extremely hot when
it is deployed. Do not touch it for at least
30 minutes after deployment.
RS
RS–286
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
• Use gloves and safety glasses when
handling a deployed airbag.
• Do not apply water to a deployed airbag.
• Always wash your hands with water after
completing the operation.
HINT:
The airbag is deployed as the SST activation
switch LED illuminates.
RS
2.
DISPOSE OF ONLY FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG
ASSEMBLY
NOTICE:
• When disposing of the airbag, never use the
customer's vehicle to deploy the airbag.
• Be sure to follow the procedure detailed below
when deploying the airbag.
HINT:
Prepare a battery as the power source to deploy the
airbag.
(a) Check if SST is functioning properly.
SST 09082-00700
(1) Connect the SST's red clip to the positive (+)
battery terminal and the black clip to the
negative (-) battery terminal.
HINT:
The yellow connector will be used to connect to
another SST in a later step.
SST
C110371E03
SST
C110475E02
(2) Press the SST activation switch, and check that
the LED of the SST activation switch
illuminates.
CAUTION:
If the LED illuminates when the activation
switch is not pressed, SST may have a
malfunction, in which case that SST should
not be used.
(3) Disconnect SST from the battery.
(b) Remove the front passenger airbag (see page RS281).
CAUTION:
• When removing the airbag, work must be
started at least 90 seconds after the ignition
switch is turned OFF and the cable is
disconnected from the negative (-) battery
terminal.
• When storing the airbag, keep the airbag
deployment side facing upward.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
A
Stripped Wire Harness Section
B104882E03
RS–287
(c) Using service wire harnesses for the vehicle, tie
down the airbag to a tire.
Wire harness:
Stripped wire harness section A:
1.25 mm2 or more (0.0019 in.2 or more)
NOTICE:
Use a tire that you are planning to throw away,
as the airbag deployment may damage the tire.
CAUTION:
Do not use wire harnesses that are too thin or
any other substitute items to tie down the front
passenger airbag assembly. They may snap
when the airbag deploys. Always use vehicle
wire harnesses that have an area of at least 1.25
mm2 (0.0019 in.2).
HINT:
To calculate the area of the stripped wire harness
section:
Area = 3.14 x Diameter2 /4
(1) Position the airbag inside the tire so that the
brackets contact the tire.
Tire size:
Width minimum: 185 mm (7.28 in.)
Inner diameter minimum: 360 mm (14.17
in.)
(2) Wind 3 wire harnesses at least twice around
the airbag brackets and tire.
Inner
Diameter
Width
Tire
H043761E04
CAUTION:
• Tightly wind the wire harnesses around
the brackets so that there is no slack.
RS
RS–288
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
• Make sure that the wire harnesses are
tight. If there is slack in a wire harness,
the airbag may come loose when it is
deployed.
• Always tie down the airbag with the
airbag deployment side facing inside the
tire.
RS
(d) Install SST.
SST 09082-00802 (09082-10801, 09082-30801)
(1) Connect the SST connectors to the airbag.
SST
H043762E03
Tires (2 or more)
Tires (2 or more)
H044501E03
(e) Place the tires.
(1) Place at least 2 tires under the tire to which the
airbag is tied.
(2) Place at least 2 tires on top of the tire to which
the airbag is tied. The top tire should have a
disc wheel installed.
NOTICE:
• Do not place the SST connector under
the tire as the connector may be
damaged.
• Use a disc wheel that you are planning to
throw away, as the airbag deployment
will damage the disc wheel.
• Use tires that you are planning to throw
away, as the airbag deployment may
damage the tires.
(3) Tie the tires together with 2 wire harnesses.
CAUTION:
Make sure that the wire harnesses are tight.
If there is slack in a wire harness, the tires
may come loose when the airbag is
deployed.
H042763E01
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – FRONT PASSENGER AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
RS–289
(f)
Front Passenger Airbag
Battery
SST
10 m or more
A125172E02
H041436E05
Install SST.
(1) Connect the SST connector.
SST 09082-00700
NOTICE:
To avoid damaging the SST connector and
wire harness, do not lock the secondary
lock of the twin lock. Also, secure some
slack for the SST wire harness inside the
tire.
(g) Deploy the airbag.
(1) Connect the SST's red clip to the positive (+)
battery terminal and the black clip to the
negative (-) battery terminal.
(2) Check that no one is within a 10 m (33 ft.)
radius of the airbag.
(3) Press the SST activation switch and deploy the
airbag.
CAUTION:
When deploying the airbag, make sure that
no one is near the tires.
HINT:
The airbag is deployed as the SST activation
switch LED illuminates.
(h) Dispose of the airbag.
CAUTION:
• The airbag becomes extremely hot when it is
deployed. Do not touch it for at least 30
minutes after deployment.
• Use gloves and safety glasses when handling
a deployed airbag.
• Do not apply water to a deployed airbag.
• Always wash your hands with water after
completing the operation.
(1) Remove the airbag from the tire.
(2) Place the airbag in a plastic bag, tie it tightly
and dispose of it in the same way as other
general parts.
RS
RS–290
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
RESTRAINTS
COMPONENTS
RS
CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
14 (143, 10)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
)
B126631E02
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
RS–291
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
CHECK CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(VEHICLE NOT INVOLVED IN COLLISION)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (see page RS41).
(b) With the curtain shield airbag installed on the
vehicle, perform a visual check. If any of the defects
mentioned below are present, replace the curtain
shield airbag with a new one:
Cuts, minute cracks or marked discoloration on the
curtain shield airbag.
CAUTION:
For removal and installation of the curtain shield
airbag assembly, be sure to follow the correct
procedures.
H043770E02
2.
H043771E04
CHECK CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(VEHICLE INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG
NOT DEPLOYED)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (see page RS41).
(b) With the curtain shield airbag removed from the
vehicle, perform a visual check. If there are any
defects as mentioned below, replace the curtain
shield airbag with a new one:
• Cuts, minute cracks or marked discoloration on
the curtain shield airbag.
• Cracks or other damage to the connectors.
CAUTION:
For removal and installation of the curtain shield
airbag assembly, be sure to follow the correct
procedures.
RS
RS–292
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
REMOVAL
CAUTION:
Be sure to read the precautionary notices concerning the
SRS airbag system before servicing it (see page RS-1).
RS
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE ROOF HEADLINING ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the roof headlining (see page IR-7).
3.
REMOVE CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connector.
NOTICE:
When handling the airbag connector, take care
not to damage the airbag wire harness.
(b) Remove the 3 clips, 9 bolts and curtain shield airbag
in the order shown in the illustration.
H042952E01
Clip
Clip
Clip
1
2
3
8
9
7
6
5
4
H043773E03
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
RS–293
INSTALLATION
CAUTION:
Be sure to read the precautionary notices concerning the
SRS airbag system before servicing it (see page RS-1).
1.
INSTALL CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the curtain shield airbag with the 9 bolts and 3
clips in the order shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
Do not twist the curtain shield airbag assembly
when installing it.
Torque: 14 N*m (143 kgf*cm, 10 ft.*lbf)
Clip
Clip
Clip
9
8
7
2
1
3
4
5
6
H043773E04
(b) Connect the connector.
NOTICE:
When handling the airbag connector, take care
not to damage the airbag wire harness.
H042953E01
2.
INSTALL ROOF HEADLINING ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the roof headlining (see page IR-13).
3.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
4.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
5.
CHECK SRS WARNING LIGHT
(a) Check the SRS warning light (see page RS-31).
RS
RS–294
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
DISPOSAL
HINT:
When scrapping a vehicle equipped with an SRS or disposing
of the curtain shield airbag assembly, be sure to deploy the
airbag first in accordance with the procedure described
below. If any abnormality occurs with the airbag deployment,
contact the SERVICE DEPARTMENT of TOYOTA MOTOR
SALES, U.S.A., INC.
CAUTION:
• Never dispose of a curtain shield airbag that has an
unactivated airbag.
• The airbag produces an exploding sound when it is
deployed, so perform the operation outdoors and
where it will not create a nuisance to nearby residents.
• When deploying the airbag, always use the specified
SST (SRS airbag deployment tool).
• Perform the operation in a place away from electrical
noise.
• When deploying the airbag, perform the operation at
least 10 m (33 ft.) away from the airbag.
• The airbag becomes very hot when it is deployed. Do
not touch it for at least 30 minutes after activation.
• Use gloves and safety glasses when handling a
deployed airbag.
• Do not apply water to a deployed airbag.
• Always wash your hands with water after completing
the operation.
RS
1.
SST
C110371E01
DISPOSE OF CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
TOGETHER WITH VEHICLE
HINT:
Prepare a battery as the power source to deploy the
airbag.
(a) Check if SST is functioning properly (see page RS270).
(b) Follow the "Precaution" (see page RS-1).
(c) Disconnect the cable from the negative battery
terminal. Wait at least 90 seconds after
disconnecting the cable to prevent the airbag from
deploying.
(d) Remove the roof headlining assembly (see page IR7).
(e) Install SST.
(1) Disconnect the connector from the curtain
shield airbag.
NOTICE:
When handling the airbag connector, take
care not to damage the airbag wire harness.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
RS–295
(2) After connecting SST to each other, connect
them to the curtain shield airbag.
SST 09082-00700, 09082-00802 (0908210801, 09082-20801)
NOTICE:
To avoid damaging the SST connector and
wire harness, do not lock the secondary
lock of the twin lock.
SST
SST
H043774E03
Battery
SST
10 m or more
C110501E02
(f)
2.
(3) Move SST at least 10 m (33 ft.) away from the
vehicle rear side window.
(4) Maintaining enough clearance for the SST wire
harness in the rear side window, close all the
doors and windows of the vehicle.
NOTICE:
Take care not to damage the SST wire
harness.
(5) Connect the SST's red clip to the battery
positive (+) terminal and the black clip to the
battery negative (-) terminal.
Deploy the airbag.
(1) Check that no one is inside the vehicle or within
a 10 m (33 ft.) radius of the vehicle.
(2) Press the SST activation switch and deploy the
airbag.
CAUTION:
• When deploying the airbag, make sure
that no one is near the vehicle.
• The airbag becomes very hot when it is
deployed. Do not touch it for at least 30
minutes after activation.
• Use gloves and safety glasses when
handling a deployed airbag.
• Do not apply water to a deployed airbag.
• Always wash your hands with water after
completing the operation.
HINT:
The airbag is deployed as the LED of the SST
activation switch comes on.
DISPOSE OF ONLY CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG
ASSEMBLY
NOTICE:
• When disposing of the curtain shield airbag,
never use the customer's vehicle to deploy the
airbag.
• Be sure to follow the procedure detailed below
when deploying the airbag.
HINT:
Prepare a battery as the power source to deploy the
airbag.
RS
RS–296
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
SST
RS
C110371E01
(a) Check if SST is functioning properly (see page RS270).
(b) Remove the curtain shield airbag assembly (see
page RS-291).
CAUTION:
When removing the curtain shield airbag, work
must be started at least 90 seconds after the
ignition switch is turned OFF and the negative () terminal cable is disconnected from the
battery.
(c) Cut off the deployment section of the curtain shield
airbag.
H043775E02
A
Stripped Wire Harness Section
B104882E08
Width
Inner
Diameter
H043776E03
(d) Using a service wire harness for the vehicle, tie
down the curtain shield airbag to the tire.
Wire harness:
Stripped wire harness section A:
1.25 mm2 or more (0.0019 in.2 or more)
CAUTION:
Do not use wire harnesses that are too thin or
any other substitute items to tie down the
curtain shield airbag assembly. They may snap
when the airbag deploys. Always use vehicle
wire harnesses that have an area of at least 1.25
mm2 (0.0019 in.2).
HINT:
To calculate the area of the stripped wire harness
section:
Area = 3.14 x Diameter2/4
(1) Position the curtain shield airbag inside the tire
as shown in the illustration.
Tire size:
Must exceed the following dimensions
Width:
185 mm (7.28 in.)
Inner diameter:
360 mm (14.17 in.)
CAUTION:
Make sure that the wire harness is tight. If
there is slack in the wire harness, the
curtain shield airbag assembly may become
loose due to the shock when the airbag is
deployed.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
RS–297
NOTICE:
Use tires that you are planning to throw
away, as the airbag deployment may
damage the tires.
(e) Install SST.
(1) After connecting SST to each other, connect
them to the curtain shield airbag.
SST 09082-00802 (09082-10801, 0908220801)
(f) Place the tires.
CAUTION:
Place the curtain shield airbag so that its
deployment direction is away from the ground.
SST
H043777E03
Tires (2 or more)
Tires (2 or more)
(1) Place at least 2 tires under the tire to which the
curtain shield airbag is tied.
(2) Place at least 2 tires over the tire to which the
curtain shield airbag is tied. The top tire should
have a disc wheel installed.
NOTICE:
Do not place the SST connector under the
tire because it could be damaged.
H043778E05
(3) Tie the tires together with 2 wire harnesses.
CAUTION:
Make sure that the wire harnesses are tight.
If there is slack in a wire harness, the tires
may come loose when the airbag is
deployed.
B105087
(g) Install SST.
(1) Connect the SST connector.
SST 09082-00700
NOTICE:
To avoid damaging the SST connector and
wire harness, do not lock the secondary
lock of the twin lock. Also, secure some
slack for the SST wire harness inside the
tire.
(h) Deploy the airbag.
(1) Connect the SST's red clip to the battery
positive (+) terminal and the black clip to the
battery negative (-) terminal.
(2) Check that no one is within a 10 m (33 ft.)
radius of the airbag.
Curtain Shield
Airbag Assembly LH
Battery
SST
10 m (33 ft) or more
A125173E03
RS
RS–298
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – CURTAIN SHIELD AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(3) Press the SST activation switch and deploy the
airbag.
CAUTION:
When deploying the airbag, make sure that
no one is near the tire.
HINT:
The airbag is deployed as the LED of the SST
activation switch comes on.
RS
(i)
H043780E02
Dispose of the curtain shield airbag.
CAUTION:
• The airbag becomes very hot when it is
deployed. Do not touch it for at least 30
minutes after activation.
• Use gloves and safety glasses when handling
a deployed airbag.
• Do not apply water to a deployed airbag.
• Always wash your hands with water after
completing the operation.
(1) Remove the curtain shield airbag from the tire.
(2) Place the curtain shield airbag in a plastic bag,
tie it tightly and dispose of it in the same way as
other general parts.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – FRONT SEAT SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
RS–299
FRONT SEAT SIDE AIRBAG
ASSEMBLY
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
CHECK FRONT SEAT SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(VEHICLE NOT INVOLVED IN COLLISION)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (see page RS41).
(b) With the front seat installed on the vehicle, perform
a visual check. If there are any defects as
mentioned below, replace the front seat assembly
with a new one:
Cuts, minute cracks or marked discoloration on the
front seat side airbag assembly.
CAUTION:
For removal and installation of the front seat
side airbag, be sure to follow the correct
procedures.
2.
CHECK FRONT SEAT SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(VEHICLE INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG
NOT DEPLOYED)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (see page RS41).
(b) With the front seat side airbag assembly removed
from the vehicle, perform a visual check. If there are
any defects as mentioned below, replace the front
seat with a new one:
• Cuts, minute cracks or marked discoloration on
the front seat side airbag.
• Cracks or other damage to the wire harness or
connector.
CAUTION:
For removal and installation of the front seat
side airbag, be sure to follow the correct
procedures.
H043764E02
H043765E02
RS
RS–300
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – FRONT SEAT SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
DISPOSAL
HINT:
When scrapping a vehicle equipped with an SRS or disposing
of the front seat side airbag assembly, be sure to deploy the
airbag first in accordance with the procedure described
below. If any abnormality occurs with the airbag deployment,
contact the SERVICE DEPARTMENT of TOYOTA MOTOR
SALES, U.S.A., INC.
CAUTION:
• Never dispose of a front seat side airbag assembly
that has an unactivated airbag.
• The airbag produces an exploding sound when it is
deployed, so perform the operation outdoors and
where it will not create a nuisance to nearby residents.
• When deploying the airbag, always use the specified
SST (SRS airbag deployment tool).
• Perform the operation in a place away from electrical
noise.
• When deploying the airbag, perform the operation at
least 10 m (33 ft.) away from the airbag assembly.
• The airbag becomes very hot when it is deployed. Do
not touch it for at least 30 minutes after activation.
• Use gloves and safety glasses when handling a
deployed airbag.
• Do not apply water to a deployed airbag.
• Always wash your hands with water after completing
the operation.
RS
1.
SST
C110371E01
DISPOSE OF FRONT SEAT SIDE AIRBAG
ASSEMBLY TOGETHER WITH VEHICLE
HINT:
Prepare a battery as the power source to deploy the
airbag.
(a) Check if SST is functioning properly (see page RS270).
(b) Follow the "Precaution" (see page RS-1).
(c) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-) battery
terminal. Wait at least 90 seconds after
disconnecting the cable to prevent the airbag from
deploying.
(d) Remove the front seat (see page SE-4).
HINT:
Keep the front seat assembly in the cabin.
(e) Install SST.
(1) Disconnect the yellow connector from the front
seat side airbag.
NOTICE:
When handling the airbag connector, take
care not to damage the airbag wire harness.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – FRONT SEAT SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
RS–301
(2) Connect the SST connector to the front seat
side airbag connector.
SST 09082-00700, 09082-00750
NOTICE:
To avoid damaging the SST connector and
wire harness, do not lock the secondary
lock of the twin lock.
(3) Install the front seat (see page SE-10).
SST
H043766E03
Battery
SST
10 m or more
C110476E03
(f)
2.
(4) Move SST at least 10 m (33 ft.) away from the
vehicle front side window.
(5) Maintaining enough clearance for the SST wire
harness in the front side window, close all the
doors and windows of the vehicle.
NOTICE:
Take care not to damage the SST wire
harness.
(6) Connect the SST's red clip to the battery
positive (+) terminal and the black clip to the
battery negative (-) terminal.
Deploy the airbag.
(1) Check that no one is inside the vehicle or within
a 10 m (33 ft.) radius of the vehicle.
(2) Press the SST activation switch and deploy the
airbag.
CAUTION:
• When deploying the airbag, make sure
that no one is near the vehicle.
• The airbag becomes very hot when it is
deployed. Do not touch it for at least 30
minutes after activation.
• Use gloves and safety glasses when
handling a deployed airbag.
• Do not apply water to a deployed airbag.
• Always wash your hands with water after
completing the operation.
HINT:
The airbag is deployed as the LED of the SST
activation switch comes on.
DISPOSE OF ONLY FRONT SEAT SIDE AIRBAG
ASSEMBLY
NOTICE:
• When disposing of the front seat side airbag,
never use the customer's vehicle to deploy the
airbag.
• Be sure to follow the procedure detailed below
when deploying the airbag.
HINT:
Prepare a battery as the power source to deploy the
airbag.
RS
RS–302
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – FRONT SEAT SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
SST
RS
C110371E01
Wire Harness Diameter
A
Stripped Wire Harness Section
B104882E09
(a) Check if SST is functioning properly (see page RS270).
(b) Remove the front seat side airbag.
(1) Remove the front seat (see page SE-4).
(2) Remove the 2 nuts and the front seat side
airbag from the seatback assembly.
CAUTION:
• When removing the front seat side
airbag, work must be started at least 90
seconds after the ignition switch is
turned OFF and the negative (-) terminal
cable is disconnected from the battery.
• When storing the front seat side airbag,
keep the airbag deployment side facing
upward.
(c) Using a service wire harness for the vehicle, tie
down the front seat side airbag to the tire.
Wire harness:
Stripped wire harness section A:
1.25 mm2 or more (0.0019 in.2 or more)
HINT:
To calculate the area of the stripped wire harness
section:
Area = 3.14 x Diameter2/4
CAUTION:
Do not use wire harnesses that are too thin or
any other substitute items to tie down the front
seat side airbag. They may snap when the
airbag deploys. Always use vehicle wire
harnesses that have an area of at least 1.25 mm2
(0.0019 in.2).
(1) Install the 2 nuts to the front seat side airbag.
H043781E02
(2) Wind the wire harness around the stud bolts of
the front seat side airbag as shown in the
illustration.
H043767E02
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – FRONT SEAT SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
Width
Inner
Diameter
H043768E04
RS–303
(3) Position the front seat side airbag inside the
tire.
Tire size:
Must exceed the following dimensions
Width:
185 mm (7.28 in.)
Inner diameter:
360 mm (14.17 in.)
CAUTION:
• Make sure that the wire harness is tight.
If there is slack in the wire harness, the
front seat side airbag may become loose
due to the shock when the airbag is
deployed.
• Always tie down the front seat side
airbag with the airbag deployment
direction facing inside the tire.
NOTICE:
Use tires that you are planning to throw
away, as the airbag deployment may
damage the tires.
(d) Install SST.
(1) Connect the SST connector to the front seat
side airbag connector.
SST 09082-00750
SST
H043769E04
Tires (2 or more)
Tires (2 or more)
(e) Place the tires.
(1) Place at least 2 tires under the tire to which the
front seat side airbag is tied.
(2) Place at least 2 tires over the tire to which the
front seat side airbag is tied. The top tire should
have a disc wheel installed.
NOTICE:
Do not place the SST connector under the
tire because it could be damaged.
H043800E03
(3) Tie the tires together with 2 wire harnesses.
CAUTION:
Make sure that the wire harnesses are tight.
If there is slack in a wire harness, the tires
may come loose when the airbag is
deployed.
B105087
RS
RS–304
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – FRONT SEAT SIDE AIRBAG ASSEMBLY
(f)
Front Seat Side Airbag
Assembly LH
RS
Battery
SST
10 m (33 ft) or more
A125222E03
H000544
Install SST.
(1) Connect the SST connector.
SST 09082-00700
NOTICE:
To avoid damaging the SST connector and
wire harness, do not lock the secondary
lock of the twin lock. Also, secure some
slack for the SST wire harness inside the
tire.
(g) Deploy the airbag.
(1) Connect the SST's red clip to the battery
positive (+) terminal and the black clip to the
battery negative (-) terminal.
(2) Check that no one is within a 10 m (33 ft.)
radius of the airbag.
(3) Press the SST activation switch and deploy the
airbag.
CAUTION:
When deploying the airbag, make sure that
no one is near the tire.
HINT:
The airbag is deployed as the LED of the SST
activation switch comes on.
(h) Dispose of the front seat side airbag assembly.
CAUTION:
• The airbag becomes very hot when it is
deployed. Do not touch it for at least 30
minutes after activation.
• Use gloves and safety glasses when handling
a deployed airbag.
• Do not apply water to a deployed airbag.
• Always wash your hands with water after
completing the operation.
(1) Remove the front seat side airbag from the tire.
(2) Place the front seat side airbag in a plastic bag,
tie it tightly and dispose of it in the same way as
other general parts.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
RS–305
CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
RESTRAINTS
COMPONENTS
RS
CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
17.5 (178, 13)
NO. 3 AIR DUCT REAR
INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL LOWER
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
)
B126632E02
RS–306
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
RS
1.
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
(VEHICLE NOT INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND
AIRBAG NOT DEPLOYED)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (see page RS41).
2.
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
(VEHICLE INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG
NOT DEPLOYED)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (see page RS41).
3.
CHECK CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
(VEHICLE INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG
DEPLOYED)
(a) Replace the center airbag sensor.
CAUTION:
For removal and installation of the center airbag
sensor assembly, be sure to follow the correct
procedures.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
RS–307
REMOVAL
CAUTION:
Be sure to read the precautionary notices concerning the
SRS airbag system before servicing it (see page RS-1).
H043784E02
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL
LOWER CENTER (See page IP-18)
3.
REMOVE NO. 3 AIR DUCT REAR
4.
REMOVE CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 3 bolts and airbag sensor.
(b) Disconnect the airbag sensor connectors.
RS
RS–308
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
INSTALLATION
CAUTION:
Be sure to read the precautionary notices concerning the
SRS airbag system before servicing it (see page RS-1).
RS
1.
INSTALL CENTER AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the airbag sensor with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 17.5 N*m (178 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
CAUTION:
• If the airbag sensor has been dropped, or
there are any cracks, dents or other defects in
the case, bracket or connector, replace it with
a new one.
• When installing the airbag sensor, be careful
that the SRS wiring does not interfere with
other parts and that it is not pinched between
other parts.
(b) Connect the airbag sensor connectors.
2.
INSTALL NO. 3 AIR DUCT REAR
3.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL
LOWER CENTER (See page IP-21)
4.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
5.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
6.
CHECK SRS WARNING LIGHT
(a) Check the SRS warning light (see page RS-31).
H043784E03
RS–308
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR
FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
RESTRAINTS
COMPONENTS
RS
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR RH
FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR LH
17.5 (178, 13)
ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
)
B126633E02
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR
RS–309
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
CHECK FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR (VEHICLE NOT
INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG NOT
DEPLOYED)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (see page RS41).
2.
CHECK FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR (VEHICLE
INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG NOT
DEPLOYED)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (see page RS41).
(b) If the front fender of the vehicle or its periphery are
damaged, perform a visual check:
• Check for cracks, dents or chips in the case.
• Check for cracks, dents, chips and scratches in
the connector.
• Check for peeling of the label or damage on the
serial number.
If any of the defects mentioned above are present,
replace the front airbag sensor with a new one.
CAUTION:
For removal and installation of the front airbag
sensor, be sure to follow the correct
procedures.
3.
CHECK FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR (VEHICLE
INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG DEPLOYED)
(a) Replace the front airbag sensor.
CAUTION:
• For removal and installation of the front
airbag sensor, be sure to follow the correct
procedures.
• If the airbags have deployed, replace the front
airbag sensor on the side in which the
collision occurred. Replace both if necessary.
RS
RS–310
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR
REMOVAL
CAUTION:
Be sure to read the precautionary notices concerning the
SRS airbag system before servicing it (see page RS-1).
RS
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
3.
REMOVE ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
4.
REMOVE FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR LH
(a) Disconnect the sensor connector.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and sensor.
5.
REMOVE FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR RH
(a) Disconnect the sensor connector.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and sensor.
H043786E02
C127028
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR
RS–311
INSTALLATION
CAUTION:
Be sure to read the precautionary notices concerning the
SRS airbag system before servicing it (see page RS-1).
1.
INSTALL FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR LH
(a) Install the sensor with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 17.5 N*m (178 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
CAUTION:
• If the airbag sensor has been dropped, or
there are any cracks, dents or other defects in
the case or connector, replace it with a new
one.
• When installing the airbag sensor, make sure
that the SRS wiring does not interfere with
other parts and is not pinched between other
parts.
(b) Check that there is no free play in the installation
parts of the sensor.
(c) Connect the sensor connector.
2.
INSTALL FRONT AIRBAG SENSOR RH
(a) Install the sensor with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 9.0 N*m (92 kgf*cm, 80 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
• If the airbag sensor has been dropped, or
there are any cracks, dents or other defects in
the case or connector, replace it with a new
one.
• When installing the airbag sensor, make sure
that the SRS wiring does not interfere with
other parts and is not pinched between other
parts.
(b) Check that there is no free play in the installation
parts of the sensor.
(c) Connect the sensor connector.
3.
INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER LH
4.
INSTALL ENGINE UNDER COVER RH
5.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
6.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
7.
CHECK SRS WARNING LIGHT
(a) Check the SRS warning light (see page RS-31).
H043786E03
C127028
RS
RS–312
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR
SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
RESTRAINTS
COMPONENTS
RS
FRONT SEAT OUTER
BELT ASSEMBLY LH
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
REAR DOOR OPENING
TRIM WEATHERSTRIP LH
42 (428, 31)
9.0 (92, 80 in.*lbf)
SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY LH
FRONT DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP LH
REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
CENTER PILLAR GARNISH LOWER LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
)
FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
B126634E03
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR
RS–313
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
CHECK SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR (VEHICLE NOT
INVOLVED IN COLLISION)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (see page RS41).
2.
CHECK SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR (VEHICLE INVOLVED
IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG NOT DEPLOYED)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (see page RS31).
(b) When the center pillar of the vehicle or its periphery
are damaged, check if there is any damage to the
side airbag sensor. If there are any defects as
mentioned below, replace the side airbag sensor
with a new one:
• Cracks, dents or chips on the sensor housing.
• Cracks or other damage to the connector.
• Peeling off of the label or damage to the serial
number.
CAUTION:
For removal and installation of the side airbag
sensor, be sure to follow the correct
procedures.
3.
CHECK SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR (VEHICLE INVOLVED
IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG DEPLOYED)
(a) Replace the side airbag sensor.
CAUTION:
• For removal and installation of the side airbag
sensor, be sure to follow the correct
procedures.
• If the airbags have deployed, replace the side
airbag sensor on the side in which the
collision occurred. Replace both if necessary.
RS
RS–314
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR
REMOVAL
CAUTION:
Be sure to read the precautionary notices concerning the
SRS airbag system before servicing it (see page RS-1).
RS
H043789E03
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH
side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
2.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH (See page
IR-7)
3.
REMOVE REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH (See page
IR-9)
4.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP LH
5.
REMOVE REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP LH
6.
REMOVE CENTER PILLAR GARNISH LOWER LH
(See page IR-9)
7.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY LH
(See page SB-9)
8.
REMOVE SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the 2 nuts and sensor.
(b) Disconnect the connector.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR
RS–315
INSTALLATION
CAUTION:
Be sure to read the precautionary notices concerning the
SRS airbag system before servicing it (see page RS-1).
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
INSTALL SIDE AIRBAG SENSOR ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the sensor with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 9.0 N*m (92 kgf*cm, 80 in.*lbf)
CAUTION:
• If the airbag sensor has been dropped, or
there are any cracks, dents or other defects in
the case, bracket or connector, replace it with
a new one.
• When installing the airbag sensor, be careful
that the SRS wiring does not interfere with
other parts and that it is not pinched between
other parts.
(b) Check that there is no looseness in the installation
parts of the sensor.
(c) Connect the connector.
2.
INSTALL FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY LH
(See page SB-10)
3.
INSTALL CENTER PILLAR GARNISH LOWER LH
(See page IR-17)
4.
INSTALL REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP LH
5.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP LH
6.
INSTALL REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH (See page
IR-18)
7.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH (See page
IR-19)
8.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
9.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
H043789E02
10. CHECK SRS WARNING LIGHT
(a) Check the SRS warning light (see page RS-31).
RS
RS–316
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – REAR AIRBAG SENSOR
REAR AIRBAG SENSOR
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
RESTRAINTS
COMPONENTS
RS
REAR SIDE SEATBACK FRAME LH
17.5 (178, 13)
REAR AIRBAG SENSOR LH
REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
)
B126635E02
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – REAR AIRBAG SENSOR
RS–317
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
CHECK REAR AIRBAG SENSOR (VEHICLE NOT
INVOLVED IN COLLISION)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (see page RS41).
2.
CHECK REAR AIRBAG SENSOR (VEHICLE
INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG NOT
DEPLOYED)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (see page RS41).
(b) When the quarter panel of the vehicle or its
periphery is damaged, check if there is any damage
to the rear airbag sensor. If there are any defects as
mentioned below, replace the rear airbag sensor
with a new one:
• Cracks, dents or chips on the sensor housing.
• Cracks or other damage to the connector.
• Peeling off of the label or damage to the serial
number.
CAUTION:
For removal and installation of the rear airbag
sensor, be sure to follow the correct
procedures.
3.
CHECK REAR AIRBAG SENSOR (VEHICLE
INVOLVED IN COLLISION AND AIRBAG DEPLOYED)
(a) Replace the rear airbag sensor.
CAUTION:
• For removal and installation of the rear airbag
sensor, be sure to follow the correct
procedures.
• If the airbags are deployed, replace the rear
airbag sensor on the side in which the
collision occurred. Replace both if necessary.
RS
RS–318
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – REAR AIRBAG SENSOR
REMOVAL
CAUTION:
Be sure to read the precautionary notices concerning the
SRS airbag system before servicing (see page RS-1).
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
RS
H043790E03
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY (See
page SE-15)
3.
REMOVE REAR SIDE SEATBACK FRAME LH
4.
REMOVE REAR AIRBAG SENSOR LH
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and sensor.
(b) Disconnect the connector.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – REAR AIRBAG SENSOR
RS–319
INSTALLATION
CAUTION:
Be sure to read the precautionary notices concerning the
SRS airbag system before servicing it (see page RS-1).
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
INSTALL REAR AIRBAG SENSOR LH
(a) Install the sensor with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 17.5 N*m (178 kgf*cm, 13 in.*lbf)
CAUTION:
• If the airbag sensor has been dropped, or
there are any cracks, dents or other defects in
the case, bracket or connector, replace it with
a new one.
• When installing the airbag sensor, be careful
that the SRS wiring does not interfere with
other parts and that it is not pinched between
other parts.
(b) Check that there is no looseness in the installation
parts of the airbag sensor.
(c) Connect the connector.
2.
INSTALL REAR SIDE SEATBACK FRAME LH
3.
INSTALL REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY (See
page SE-23)
4.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
5.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
6.
CHECK SRS WARNING LIGHT
(a) Check the SRS warning light (see page RS-31).
H043790E02
RS
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – SEAT POSITION SENSOR
RS–319
SEAT POSITION SENSOR
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
RESTRAINTS
COMPONENTS
RS
FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY
FRONT SEAT CUSHION SHIELD
“TORX” SCREW
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
SEAT SLIDE POSITION
SENSOR PROTECTOR
SEAT POSITION SENSOR
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
)
B126636E03
RS–320
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – SEAT POSITION SENSOR
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
RS
1.
CHECK SEAT POSITION SENSOR (VEHICLE NOT
INVOLVED IN COLLISION)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (see page RS41).
2.
CHECK SEAT POSITION SENSOR (VEHICLE
INVOLVED IN COLLISION)
(a) Perform a diagnostic system check (see page RS41).
(b) Even if the airbag was not deployed, check if there
is any damage to the seat position sensor.
If there are any defects as mentioned below, replace
the seat position sensor with a new one:
• Cracks, dents or chips on the sensor housing.
• Cracks or other damage to the connector.
CAUTION:
For removal and installation of the seat position
sensor, be sure to follow the correct
procedures.
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – SEAT POSITION SENSOR
RS–321
REMOVAL
CAUTION:
Be sure to read the precautionary notices concerning the
SRS airbag system before servicing it (see page RS-1).
Seat Slide Position
Sensor Protector
Seat Position
Airbag Sensor
Torx
Screw
H043792E03
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the front seat assembly (see page SE-4).
3.
REMOVE SEAT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Remove the seat slide position sensor protector.
(b) Disconnect the connector.
(c) Using a T30 "torx" socket, remove the screw and
seat position sensor.
RS
RS–322
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM – SEAT POSITION SENSOR
INSTALLATION
CAUTION:
Be sure to read the precautionary notices concerning the
SRS airbag system before servicing it (see page RS-1).
RS
1.
INSTALL SEAT POSITION SENSOR
(a) Check that the power switch is off.
(b) Check that the negative battery (-) terminal is
disconnected.
CAUTION:
After disconnecting the cable from the negative
battery terminal, wait for at least 90 seconds
before starting the operation.
(c) Using a 1 mm (0.039 in.) feeler gauge, install the
seat position sensor.
NOTICE:
• If the seat position sensor has been dropped,
or there are any cracks, dents or other
defects in the case or connector, replace the
seat position sensor with a new one.
• When installing the seat position sensor, be
careful that the SRS wiring does not interfere
with other parts and that it is not pinched
between other parts.
HINT:
Be sure that the clearance between the seat
position sensor and the seat rail is within 0.6 mm
(0.023 in.) to 1.4 mm (0.055 in.).
(d) Using a "torx" socket wrench (T30), tighten the
"torx" screw to install the seat position sensor.
Torque: 8.0 N*m (82 kgf*cm, 71 in.*lbf)
(e) Make sure that the clearance between the seat
position sensor and the seat rail is within 0.6 mm
(0.023 in.) to 1.4 mm (0.055 in.).
(f) Check that there is no looseness in the installation
parts of the seat position sensor.
(g) Connect the connector.
(h) Install the seat slide position sensor protector to the
seat position sensor.
2.
INSTALL FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the front seat assembly (see page SE-10).
3.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
4.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
5.
CHECK SRS WARNING LIGHT
(a) Check the SRS warning light (see page RS-31).
Seat Position
Airbag Sensor
1 mm
Feeler Gauge
Seat Rail
H043795E03
SEAT BELT – SEAT BELT WARNING SYSTEM
SB–1
SEAT BELT WARNING SYSTEM
SEAT BELT
RESTRAINTS
PARTS LOCATION
COMBINATION METER ASSEMBLY
SB
DRIVER SEAT BELT WARNING LIGHT
PASSENGER SEAT BELT WARNING LIGHT
DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
- GAUGE FUSE
FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY
(for Driver Side)
FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY
(for Front Passenger Side)
B127650E01
SB–2
SEAT BELT – SEAT BELT WARNING SYSTEM
SB
ENGINE ROOM JUNCTION BLOCK, RELAY BLOCK
- DOME FUSE
B127651E01
SB–3
SEAT BELT – SEAT BELT WARNING SYSTEM
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
from Power Source
SB
GAUGE
DOME
Combination Meter
IG+
PBEW
Driver Seat Belt
Warning Light
from Multiplex
Communication
System
Front Passenger Seat
Belt Warning Light
Front Seat Inner Belt
(for Front Driver Side)
B127652E01
SB–4
SEAT BELT – SEAT BELT WARNING SYSTEM
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
When the power switch is ON (IG) and the passenger or
driver side seat belt is not fastened, the seat belt warning
system repeatedly flashes the seat belt warning light. The
system determines the seat belt status by checking if the seat
belt buckle switch is OFF (seat belt fastened) or ON (seat belt
unfastened).
SB
SB–5
SEAT BELT – SEAT BELT WARNING SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
Use the table below to help determine the cause of the
problem symptom. The potential causes of the symptoms are
listed in order of probability in the "Suspected area" column of
the table. Check each symptom by checking the suspected
areas in the order they are listed. Replace parts as
necessary.
Seat belt warning system
Symptom
Driver side seat belt warning light does not flash
Driver side seat belt warning light does not illuminate
Passenger side seat belt warning light does not flash
Passenger side seat belt warning light does not
illuminate
Suspected area
See page
1. DOME fuse
SB-1
2. GAUGE fuse
SB-1
3. Front seat inner belt (for driver side)
SB-6
4. Combination meter
ME-36
5. Wire harness
-
1. Front seat inner belt (for driver side)
SB-6
2. Combination meter
ME-36
3. Wire harness
-
1. DOME fuse
SB-1
2. GAUGE fuse
SB-1
3. Combination meter
ME-38
4. Front seat inner belt (for passenger side)
-
5. Wire harness
-
1. Combination meter
ME-38
2. Front seat inner belt (for passenger side)
-
3. Wire harness
-
SB
SB–5
SEAT BELT – FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY
FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY
SEAT BELT
RESTRAINTS
COMPONENTS
SB
FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY RH
42 (428, 31)
FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY RH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B128998E01
SB–6
SEAT BELT – FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY
REMOVAL
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the RH side.
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY RH (See page
SE-4)
3.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Remove the bolt and inner belt.
SB
INSPECTION
1.
Release
Fasten
B078374E01
INSPECT FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY (for
Driver Side)
(a) Measure the resistance of the buckle switch.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
Seat belt is unfastened
Below 1 Ω
1-2
Seat belt is fastened
1 MΩ or higher
If the result is not as specified, replace the belt
assembly.
SEAT BELT – FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY
SB–7
INSTALLATION
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the RH side.
1.
INSTALL FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Install the inner belt with the bolt.
Torque: 42 N*m (428 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
2.
INSTALL FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY RH (See page SE10)
3.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
4.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
SB
SEAT BELT – FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY
SB–7
FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT
ASSEMBLY
PRECAUTION
B069710E01
CAUTION:
Replace the faulty parts of the seat belt systems (outer
belt, inner belt, bolts, nuts, adjustable shoulder anchor,
tether anchor hardware and other related parts). When
inspecting a vehicle that was in a collision, be sure to
check all of the seat belt systems regardless of whether
or not the system was activated in the collision. Replace
any damaged or malfunctioning systems.
1. RUNNING TEST (IN SAFE AREA)
CAUTION:
Conduct this test in a safe area.
(a) Fasten the front seat belt.
(b) Drive the vehicle at 16 km/h (10 mph) and firmly
depress the brake pedal. Check that the belts lock
and cannot be extended at this time.
If a belt does not lock, replace the seat belt
assembly (see page SB-9).
HINT:
Inspect a seat belt assembly before installing it (see
page SB-9).
SB
SB–8
SEAT BELT – FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY
COMPONENTS
SB
FRONT SHOULDER BELT
ANCHOR ADJUSTER ASSEMBLY
CENTER PILLAR GARNISH RH
42 (428, 31)
REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP RH
FRONT DOOR
OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP
RH
FRONT SEAT OUTER
BELT ASSEMBLY RH
42 (428, 31)
REAR DOOR SCUFF
PLATE RH
ANCHOR COVER
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
42 (428, 31)
FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH
CENTER PILLAR GARNISH LOWER RH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B128997E01
SEAT BELT – FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY
SB–9
REMOVAL
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the LH side and RH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the RH side.
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH (See page
IR-7)
3.
REMOVE REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH (See page
IR-9)
4.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP RH
5.
REMOVE REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP RH
6.
REMOVE CENTER PILLAR GARNISH LOWER RH
(See page IR-9)
7.
REMOVE CENTER PILLAR GARNISH RH (See page
IR-10)
8.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Remove the anchor cover and floor anchor bolt.
(b) Remove the nut and shoulder anchor.
(c) Disconnect the pretensioner connector.
(d) Remove the 2 bolts and outer belt.
9.
REMOVE FRONT SHOULDER BELT ANCHOR
ADJUSTER ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the bolt and anchor adjuster.
B074545E01
45°
INSPECTION
Unlock
1.
Lock
Retractor
B074547E02
INSPECT FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY
NOTICE:
Do not disassemble the retractor.
(a) Before installing the outer belt, check the ELR.
(1) When the inclination of the retractor is 15° or
less, check that the belt can be pulled from the
retractor. When the inclination of the retractor is
over 45° , check that the belt locks.
If the result is not as specified, replace the
outer belt assembly.
SB
SB–10
SEAT BELT – FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY
INSTALLATION
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the RH side.
• A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the
standard bolt chart (see page SS-2).
SB
1.
INSTALL FRONT SHOULDER BELT ANCHOR
ADJUSTER ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the belt anchor adjuster with the bolt.
Torque: 42 N*m (428 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
2.
INSTALL FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Install the outer belt to the center pillar with the 2
bolts.
Torque: 5.0 N*m (51 kgf*cm, 44 in.*lbf) for upper
bolt
42 N*m (428 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf) for lower
bolt
(b) Connect the pretensioner connector as shown in the
illustration.
(c) Install the outer belt with the bolt on the shoulder
anchor side.
Torque: 42 N*m (428 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
(d) Install the shoulder anchor cover.
(e) Install the outer belt with the bolt on the floor anchor
side.
Torque: 42 N*m (428 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
(f) Install the center pillar garnish RH (see page IR-17).
(g) Install the center pillar lower garnish RH (see page
IR-17).
(h) Install the floor anchor to the floor panel with the
bolt.
Torque: 42 N*m (428 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
(i) Install the front door scuff plate RH (see page IR19).
(j) Install the rear door scuff plate RH (see page IR-18).
(k) Install the front door opening trim weatherstrip RH
(see page IR-19).
(l) Install the rear door opening trim weatherstrip RH
(see page IR-17).
(m) Check if the ELR locks.
NOTICE:
The check should be performed with the outer
belt assembly installed.
(1) With the belt installed, check that the belt locks
when it is pulled out quickly.
If the operation is not as specified, replace the
outer belt assembly.
B074546E01
3.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
SEAT BELT – FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY
4.
SB–11
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
SB
SB–12
SEAT BELT – FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY
DISPOSAL
SB
SST
B106111E01
HINT:
When scrapping vehicles equipped with a seat belt
pretensioner or disposing of a front seat outer belt (with seat
belt pretensioner), always first activate the seat belt
pretensioner in accordance with the procedures described
below. If any abnormality occurs during activation of the seat
belt pretensioner, contact the SERVICE DEPARTMENT of
TOYOTA MOTOR SALES, U.S.A., INC.
CAUTION:
• Never dispose of a front seat outer belt that has a nonactivated pretensioner.
• The seat belt pretensioner produces a loud, exploding
sound when it activates. Perform the operation where
it will not be a nuisance to nearby people.
• When activating a front seat outer belt (with seat belt
pretensioner), stand at least 10 m (33 ft.) away from
the front seat outer belt.
• Use gloves and safety glasses when handling a front
seat outer belt with an activated pretensioner.
• Always wash your hands with water after completing
the disposal.
• Do not apply water to a front seat outer belt that has
an activated pretensioner.
• Perform procedures in a place away from electrical
interference.
• When activating the seat belt pretensioner, always use
the specified SST (SRS airbag deployment tool).
1.
DISPOSE OF FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY
RH (WHEN INSTALLED IN VEHICLE)
HINT:
Prepare a battery to activate the seat belt pretensioner.
(a) Check if SST is functioning properly.
SST 09082-00700
CAUTION:
When activating the seat belt pretensioner,
always use the specified SST.
SST
B106111E01
Battery
SST
B106112E01
(1) Connect the SST's red clip to the battery's
positive (+) terminal and the black clip to the
battery's negative (-) terminal.
HINT:
Do not connect the yellow connector. The
yellow connector is used to connect to the seat
belt pretensioner.
SEAT BELT – FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY
SST
B106113E01
SB–13
(2) Press the SST activation switch and check that
the LED of the SST activation switch
illuminates.
CAUTION:
If the LED illuminates when the activation
switch is not being pressed, SST may be
malfunctioning. Replace SST with a new
one.
(b) Disconnect SST from the battery.
(c) Disconnect the pretensioner connector.
(1) Disconnect the cable from the negative (-)
battery terminal.
(2) Remove the front door scuff plate RH (see
page IR-7).
(3) Remove the rear door scuff plate RH (see page
IR-9).
(4) Remove the front door opening trim
weatherstrip RH (see page IR-7).
(5) Remove the rear door opening trim
weatherstrip RH (see page IR-9).
(6) Remove the center pillar garnish lower RH (see
page IR-9).
(7) Remove the center pillar garnish upper RH
(see page IR-10).
(8) Disconnect the pretensioner connector as
shown in the illustration.
(d) Prepare SST for activation of the seat belt
pretensioner.
(1) Install the floor anchor of the seat belt.
B074545E01
SST (A)
(2) Connect SST (A) to SST (B). Then connect the
SST (B)'s connector to the seat belt
pretensioner.
SST 09082-00700, 09082-00770
NOTICE:
To avoid damaging the SST connector and
wire harness, do not lock the secondary
lock of the twin lock.
SST (B)
B106114E01
SB
SB–14
SB
SEAT BELT – FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY
(3) Move SST at least 10 m (33 ft.) away from the
front of the vehicle.
(4) Close all the doors and windows of the vehicle.
HINT:
Leave a gap in one of the windows for inserting
the SST wire harness.
NOTICE:
Take care not to damage the SST wire
harness.
(5) Connect the SST's red clip to the battery's
positive (+) terminal and the black clip to the
negative (-) terminal.
(e) Activate the seat belt pretensioner.
(1) Confirm that no one is inside the vehicle or
within 10 m (33 ft.) of the vehicle.
(2) Press the SST activation switch to activate the
seat belt pretensioner.
HINT:
The seat belt pretensioner operates at the
same time the SST activation switch's LED
illuminates.
(f) Dispose of the front seat outer belt (with the seat
belt pretensioner).
CAUTION:
• Do not touch the front seat outer belt for at
least 30 minutes after the seat belt
pretensioner has been activated. It is very
hot.
• Use gloves and safety glasses when handling
a front seat outer belt whose pretensioner
has been activated.
• Always wash your hands with water after
completing the disposal.
• Do not apply water to a front seat outer belt
that has an activated pretensioner.
HINT:
When scrapping a vehicle, activate the seat belt
pretensioner, and then scrap the vehicle with the
activated front seat outer belt installed.
10 m or More
B107392E04
2.
DISPOSE OF FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY
(WHEN NOT INSTALLED IN VEHICLE)
NOTICE:
• When only disposing of the front seat outer belt
(with the seat belt pretensioner), never use the
customer's vehicle to activate the seat belt
pretensioner.
• Be sure to follow the procedures listed below
when activating the seat belt pretensioner.
SEAT BELT – FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY
Cut Here
B079201E01
Battery
SB–15
(a) Remove the front seat outer belt.
(1) Wind the seat belt with the retractor.
(2) When the seat belt is sufficiently wound, cut the
seat belt approximately 100 mm (0.39 in.) from
the retractor, as shown in the illustration.
HINT:
The seat belt is designed so that winding the
seat belt before pretensioner activation will
decrease the pulling power of the seat belt
during pretensioner activation.
(b) Check if SST is functioning properly.
SST 09082-00700, 09082-00770
CAUTION:
When activating a seat belt pretensioner, always
use the specified SST.
SST
B106112E01
SST (A)
(c) Prepare SST for activation of the seat belt
pretensioner.
(1) Connect SST (A) to SST (B). Then connect the
SST (B)'s connector to the seat belt
pretensioner.
NOTICE:
To avoid damaging the SST connector and
wire harness, do not lock the secondary
lock of the twin lock.
SST (B)
B106114E01
(2) Place the front seat outer belt on the ground
and cover it with a tire (with wheel).
NOTICE:
Set up the front seat outer belt as shown in
the illustration.
SST (A)
SST (B)
B111676E01
10 m or more
B111677E01
(3) Move SST at least 10 m (33 ft.) away from the
wheel.
NOTICE:
Take care not to damage the SST wire
harness.
(d) Activate the seat belt pretensioner.
(1) Connect the SST's red clip to the battery's
positive (+) terminal and the black clip to the
battery's negative (-) terminal.
(2) Check that no one is within 10 m (33 ft.) of the
wheel.
SB
SB–16
SEAT BELT – FRONT SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY
(3) Press the SST activation switch to activate the
seat belt pretensioner.
HINT:
The seat belt pretensioner operates at the
same time the SST activation switch's LED
illuminates.
(e) Dispose of the front seat outer belt (with the seat
belt pretensioner).
CAUTION:
• Do not touch the front seat outer belt for at
least 30 minutes after the seat belt
pretensioner has been activated. It is very
hot.
• Use gloves and safety glasses when handling
a front seat outer belt whose pretensioner
has been activated.
• Always wash your hands with water after
completing the disposal.
• Do not apply water to a front seat outer belt
that has an activated pretensioner.
(1) Remove the tire (with wheel) and SST.
SB
(2) Place the front seat outer belt in a plastic bag,
tie the end tightly and dispose of it in the same
way as other general parts.
B060422E01
SB–16
SEAT BELT – REAR SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY
REAR SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY
SEAT BELT
RESTRAINTS
COMPONENTS
REAR SEAT BELT ASSEMBLY
OUTER CENTER (for Floor Anchor)
SB
REAR SEAT INNER
BELT ASSEMBLY RH
CHILD RESTRAINT SEAT
ANCHOR BRACKET
SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
CHILD RESTRAINT SEAT
ANCHOR BRACKET
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
42 (428, 31)
42 (428, 31)
42 (428, 31)
42 (428, 31)
REAR SEAT INNER BELT
ASSEMBLY CENTER
REAR SEAT CUSHION WITH
COVER PAD SUB-ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B128996E01
SEAT BELT – REAR SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY
SB–17
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY (See
page SE-15)
2.
DISCONNECT REAR SEAT BELT ASSEMBLY OUTER
CENTER (for Floor Anchor)
(a) Remove the bolt and floor anchor part of the seat
belt outer.
Anchor Part
B076014E04
3.
REMOVE REAR SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Remove the bolt and rear seat inner belt.
4.
REMOVE REAR SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY
CENTER
(a) Remove the bolt and rear seat inner belt.
5.
REMOVE CHILD RESTRAINT SEAT ANCHOR
BRACKET SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and anchor bracket.
6.
REMOVE CHILD RESTRAINT SEAT ANCHOR
BRACKET SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
Remove the 2 bolts and anchor bracket.
B074539E03
B074540E02
SB
SB–18
SEAT BELT – REAR SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY
INSTALLATION
HINT:
A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the standard
bolt chart (see page SS-2).
1.
INSTALL CHILD RESTRAINT SEAT ANCHOR
BRACKET SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the anchor bracket with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 42 N*m (428 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
2.
INSTALL CHILD RESTRAINT SEAT ANCHOR
BRACKET SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Install the anchor bracket with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 42 N*m (428 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
3.
INSTALL REAR SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY
CENTER
(a) Install the rear seat inner belt with the bolt, as
shown in the illustration.
Torque: 42 N*m (428 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Make sure that the anchor part does not run
onto the protruding part of the floor panel.
4.
INSTALL REAR SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Install the rear seat inner belt with the bolt, as
shown in the illustration.
Torque: 42 N*m (428 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Make sure that the anchor part does not run
onto the protruding part of the floor panel.
5.
CONNECT REAR SEAT BELT ASSEMBLY OUTER
CENTER (for Floor Anchor)
(a) Install the floor anchor part of the rear seat inner belt
with the bolt, as shown in the illustration.
Torque: 42 N*m (428 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Make sure that the anchor part does not run
onto the protruding part.
6.
INSTALL REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY (See
page SE-23)
SB
Anchor Part
Front Side
Protruding Part
B074540E01
Anchor Part
Protruding Part
Front Side
B074539E01
Anchor Part
Protruding
Part
Front
B076014E03
SB–19
SEAT BELT – REAR SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY
REAR SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY
SEAT BELT
RESTRAINTS
COMPONENTS
SB
42 (428, 31)
OUTER BELT ANCHOR
BRACKET SUB-ASSEMBLY
RH
REAR SEAT OUTER
BELT ASSEMBLY
CENTER
42 (428, 31)
42 (428, 31)
REAR SEAT OUTER
BELT ASSEMBLY RH
REAR SIDE SEAT
BACK FRAME RH
42 (428, 31)
REAR SEATBACK
ASSEMBLY RH
REAR SEAT INNER
BELT ASSEMBLY RH
REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B127653E03
SB–20
SEAT BELT – REAR SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY
REAR DOOR OPENING
TRIM WEATHERSTRIP RH
SB
ROOF SIDE GARNISH INNER RH
REAR DECK TRIM COVER
DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY RH
REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH
B128995E01
SB–21
SEAT BELT – REAR SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY
TONNEAU COVER ASSEMBLY
REAR FLOOR NO. 4 BOARD
SB
LUGGAGE HOLD BELT
STRIKER ASSEMBLY
REAR FLOOR NO. 4 BOARD
REAR FLOOR NO. 2 BOARD
REAR FLOOR NO. 1 BOARD
REAR DECK FLOOR BOX
DECK FLOOR BOX LH
B127654E03
SB–22
SEAT BELT – REAR SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY
REMOVAL
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the RH side.
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY (See
page SE-15)
3.
REMOVE REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH (See page
IR-9)
4.
REMOVE REAR SIDE SEAT BACK FRAME RH (See
page SE-15)
5.
REMOVE REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP RH
6.
REMOVE REAR SEAT BACK ASSEMBLY RH (See
page SE-15)
7.
REMOVE REAR SEAT BACK ASSEMBLY RH (See
page SE-15)
8.
REMOVE TONNEAU COVER ASSEMBLY
9.
REMOVE REAR FLOOR NO. 2 BOARD
SB
10. REMOVE REAR FLOOR NO. 1 BOARD
11. REMOVE REAR FLOOR NO. 4 BOARD
12. REMOVE DECK FLOOR BOX LH
13. REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX
14. REMOVE REAR DECK TRIM COVER (See page IR-10)
15. REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY RH
(See page IR-11)
16. REMOVE ROOF SIDE GARNISH INNER RH (See page
IR-11)
17. REMOVE REAR SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and outer belt.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and belt outer anchor bracket
RH.
18. REMOVE REAR SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY
CENTER
HINT:
RH side only.
(a) Remove the bolt and disconnect the floor anchor.
SEAT BELT – REAR SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY
B057844E03
SB–23
(b) Using a screwdriver, detach the 4 claws and remove
the cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(c) Remove the rear seat headrest RH (see page SE16).
(d) Remove the rear seat center headrest (see page
SE-16).
(e) Remove the rear seat back cover RH (see page SE17).
(f) Remove the bolt on the retractor side and belt.
SB
SB–24
SEAT BELT – REAR SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY
INSPECTION
1.
SB
Unlock
INSPECT REAR SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY
CENTER
NOTICE:
Do not disassemble the retractor.
(a) When the inclination of the retractor is 15° or less,
check that the belt can be pulled from the retractor.
When the inclination of the retractor is over 45°,
check that the belt locks.
If the operation is not as specified, replace the belt.
45q
Lock
B069510E02
Unlock
2.
45q
Lock
B060427E02
INSPECT REAR SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY
NOTICE:
Do not disassemble the retractor.
(a) When the inclination of the retractor is 15° or less,
check that the belt can be pulled from the retractor.
When the inclination of the retractor is over 45°,
check that the belt locks.
If the operation is not as specified, replace the belt.
SEAT BELT – REAR SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY
SB–25
INSTALLATION
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
• A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the
standard bolt chart (see page SS-2).
1.
INSTALL REAR SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY
CENTER
(a) Install the belt with the bolt on the retractor side.
Torque: 42 N*m (428 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
(b) Install the rear seatback cover RH (see page SE20).
(c) Install the rear seat headrest RH (see page SE-21).
(d) Install the rear seat center headrest (see page SE21).
(e) Attach the 4 claws to install the cover (see page SE22).
(f)
Anchor Part
Protruding
Part
Front
Connect the floor anchor of the belt with the bolt, as
shown in the illustration.
Torque: 42 N*m (428 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Make sure that the anchor part does not run
onto the protruding part.
2.
INSTALL REAR SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Install the belt on the retractor side with the bolt.
Torque: 42 N*m (428 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Make sure that the anchor part does not run
onto the protruding part of the side panel.
(b) Install the belt on the floor anchor side with the bolt.
Torque: 42 N*m (428 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
(c) With the belt installed, check that the belt locks
when it is pulled out quickly.
NOTICE:
The check should be performed with the outer
belt installed.
If the operation is not as specified, replace the belt.
3.
INSTALL ROOF SIDE GARNISH INNER RH (See page
IR-15)
4.
INSTALL DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Install the deck trim side panel RH (see page IR-16).
(b) Install the rear seat outer belt RH with the bolt on
the floor anchor side.
Torque: 42 N*m (428 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
5.
INSTALL REAR DECK TRIM COVER (See page IR-16)
6.
INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX
7.
INSTALL DECK FLOOR BOX LH
8.
INSTALL REAR FLOOR NO. 4 BOARD
9.
INSTALL REAR FLOOR NO. 1 BOARD
B076014E03
SB
SB–26
SEAT BELT – REAR SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY
10. INSTALL REAR FLOOR NO. 2 BOARD
11. INSTALL TONNEAU COVER ASSEMBLY
12. INSTALL REAR SEAT BACK ASSEMBLY RH (See
page SE-23)
13. INSTALL REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP RH
SB
14. INSTALL REAR SIDE SEAT BACK FRAME RH
15. INSTALL REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH
16. INSTALL REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY (See
page SE-23)
17. CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
18. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
SEAT – FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY
SE–1
FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY
SEAT
BODY
COMPONENTS
FRONT SEAT HEADREST ASSEMBLY
SEAT TRACK INNER
BRACKET COVER LH
SEAT TRACK OUTER COVER LH
37 (377, 27)
SE
FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B132582E01
SE–2
SEAT – FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY
FRONT SEAT CUSHION COVER
HOG RING
FRONT SEAT CUSHION PAD
42 (428, 31)
FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY LH
SE
RECLINING ADJUSTER
RELEASE HANDLE LH
FRONT SEAT CUSHION
INNER SHIELD LH
FRONT SEAT CUSHION SHIELD LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
B132583E01
SE–3
SEAT – FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY
FRONT SEATBACK PAD
FRONT SEAT HEADREST SUPPORT
FRONT SEATBACK COVER
HOG RING
FRONT SEAT ADJUSTER
FRAME ASSEMBLY
FRONT SEAT CUSHION
LOWER SHIELD LH
RECLINING ADJUSTER
LOWER INSIDE COVER RH
FRONT SEAT CUSHION
LOWER SHIELD RH
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
RECLINING ADJUSTER
UPPER INSIDE COVER RH
w/ Front Seat Side Airbag
SE
FRONT SEAT
ADJUSTER FRAME
OCCUPANT DETECTION ECU
(for Front Passenger Side)
RECLINING ADJUSTER
LOWER INSIDE COVER LH
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
SEAT POSITION AIRBAG SENSOR
(for Driver Side)
RECLINING ADJUSTER
UPPER INSIDE COVER LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
SEAT SLIDE POSITION PROTECTOR
Non-reusable part
B132584E01
SE–4
SEAT – FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY
REMOVAL
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE SEAT TRACK OUTER COVER LH
(a) Using a screwdriver, detach the 3 claws and remove
the seat track outer cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
3.
REMOVE SEAT TRACK INNER BRACKET COVER LH
(a) Using a screwdriver, detach the 2 claws and remove
the seat track inner bracket cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
4.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT HEADREST ASSEMBLY
5.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY
(a) Lift up the seat track adjusting handle and move the
seat to the rearmost position.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts on the front side of the seat.
(c) Lift up the seat track adjusting handle and move the
seat to the foremost position.
(d) Remove the 2 bolts on the rear side of the seat.
(e) Disconnect the connectors under the seat. Then
remove the front seat.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the vehicle body.
B078868E02
B078867E02
SE
SEAT – FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY
SE–5
DISASSEMBLY
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
CAUTION:
Wear protective gloves. Sharp surfaces on the seat
adjuster may injure your hands.
1.
REMOVE RECLINING ADJUSTER RELEASE
HANDLE LH
(a) Raise the reclining adjuster release handle to reveal
the claw.
(b) Using a screwdriver, detach the claw and remove
the release handle.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
2.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT CUSHION SHIELD LH
(a) Remove the 2 rubber bands from the back of the
front seatback cover.
Claw
B079988E01
B132586
(b) Remove the 2 screws.
(c) Using a screwdriver, detach the 2 claws and clip,
and remove the seat cushion shield.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
3.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY LH
(See page SB-6)
SE
B132590
B076921E02
4.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT CUSHION INNER SHIELD LH
(a) Remove the screw.
(b) Using a screwdriver, detach the claw and clip, and
remove the seat cushion inner shield.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
5.
REMOVE FRONT SEAT CUSHION COVER
(a) Detach the hooks and remove the 2 hog rings and
seat cushion cover (with pad) from the seat adjuster.
SE–6
SEAT – FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY
(b) Remove the 6 hog rings and seat cushion cover
from the seat cushion pad.
Hog Ring
B132587E01
6.
REMOVE FRONT SEATBACK COVER
(a) Lift up the seatback cover and remove the 3 hog
rings shown in the illustration.
Hog Ring
B076023E01
(b) Remove the 3 hog rings shown in the illustration.
Rubber
Hog Ring
B077035E01
(c) Using a screwdriver, detach the 2 hooks.
SE
Hook
T
B132588E01
(d) w/ Front Seat Side Airbag:
Remove the nut and 2 seatback cover brackets.
(e) Roll up the seatback cover.
B087721E01
SEAT – FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY
SE–7
(f)
Detach the 4 claws and remove the 2 headrest
supports.
(g) Remove the seatback cover (with pad) from the seat
adjuster.
B060977E01
(h) Remove the 4 hog rings and seatback cover from
the seatback pad.
Hog Ring
T
B132589E01
7.
REMOVE RECLINING ADJUSTER UPPER INSIDE
COVER LH
(a) Remove the screw and inside cover.
8.
REMOVE RECLINING ADJUSTER UPPER INSIDE
COVER RH
(a) Remove the screw and inside cover.
9.
REMOVE RECLINING ADJUSTER LOWER INSIDE
COVER LH
(a) Remove the screw and inside cover.
10. REMOVE RECLINING ADJUSTER LOWER INSIDE
COVER RH
(a) Remove the screw and inside cover.
11. REMOVE FRONT SEAT CUSHION LOWER SHIELD
LH
(a) Detach the claw and remove the lower shield.
12. REMOVE FRONT SEAT CUSHION LOWER SHIELD
RH
(a) Detach the claw and remove the lower shield.
13. REMOVE SEAT POSITION AIRBAG SENSOR (for
Driver Side) (See page RS-321)
14. REMOVE OCCUPANT DETECTION ECU (for Front
Passenger Side)
SE
SE–8
SEAT – FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY
REASSEMBLY
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
CAUTION:
Wear protective gloves. Sharp surfaces on the seat
adjuster may injure your hands.
Hog Ring Pliers
SE
1.
INSTALL OCCUPANT DETECTION ECU (for Front
Passenger Side)
2.
INSTALL SEAT POSITION AIRBAG SENSOR (for
Driver Side) (See page RS-321)
3.
INSTALL FRONT SEAT CUSHION LOWER SHIELD LH
(a) Attach the claw to install the lower shield.
4.
INSTALL FRONT SEAT CUSHION LOWER SHIELD
RH
(a) Attach the claw to install the lower shield.
5.
INSTALL RECLINING ADJUSTER UPPER INSIDE
COVER LH
(a) Install the inside cover with the screw.
6.
INSTALL RECLINING ADJUSTER UPPER INSIDE
COVER RH
(a) Install the inside cover with the screw.
7.
INSTALL RECLINING ADJUSTER LOWER INSIDE
COVER LH
(a) Install the inside cover with the screw.
8.
INSTALL RECLINING ADJUSTER LOWER INSIDE
COVER RH
(a) Install the inside cover with the screw.
9.
INSTALL FRONT SEATBACK COVER
NOTICE:
• Be careful not to damage the cover.
• When installing the hog rings, avoid wrinkling the
cover.
B050126E09
(a) Using hog ring pliers, install the seatback cover to
the seatback pad with 4 new hog rings.
(b) Install the seatback cover (with pad) to the seat
adjuster.
Hog Ring
T
B132589E01
SEAT – FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY
SE–9
(c) Attach the 4 claws to install the 2 headrest supports.
B060977E01
B087721E01
(d) w/ Front Seat Side Airbag:
Fully cover the airbag with the 2 seatback cover
brackets and install the nut.
Torque: 5.5 N*m (56 kgf*cm, 49 in.*lbf)
NOTICE:
• For vehicles with side airbags, the seatback
cover must be securely installed. If not, the
side airbag may not deploy properly.
• Make sure that the strap is not twisted after
installing the bracket.
• Install the bracket securely.
(e) Attach the 2 hooks to the seat adjuster.
Hook
B132588E01
T
(f)
Rubber
Using hog ring pliers, attach a rubber with 3 new
hog rings.
SE
Hog Ring
B077035E01
(g) Using hog ring pliers, install 3 new hog rings.
Hog Ring
B076023E01
SE–10
SEAT – FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY
10. INSTALL FRONT SEAT CUSHION COVER
NOTICE:
• Be careful not to damage the cover.
• When installing the hog rings, avoid wrinkling the
cover.
Hog Ring Pliers
B050126E09
(a) Using hog ring pliers, install the seat cushion cover
to the seat cushion pad with 6 new hog rings.
(b) Using hog ring pliers, install the seat cushion cover
(with pad) to the seat adjuster with 2 new hog rings
and hooks.
11. INSTALL FRONT SEAT INNER BELT ASSEMBLY LH
(See page SB-6)
Hog Ring
B132587E01
12. REMOVE FRONT SEAT CUSHION INNER SHIELD LH
(a) Attach the claw and clip to install the seat cushion
inner shield.
(b) Install the screw.
B076921E02
13. INSTALL FRONT SEAT CUSHION SHIELD LH
(a) Attach the 2 claws and clip to install the seat
cushion shield.
(b) Install the screw.
SE
B132590E01
(c) Attach the 2 rubber bands of back of the front
seatback cover.
14. INSTALL RECLINING ADJUSTER RELEASE HANDLE
LH
(a) Attach the claw to install the release handle.
B132585
SEAT – FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY
SE–11
INSTALLATION
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
INSTALL FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY
(a) Place the seat in the cabin.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the vehicle body.
(b) Connect the connectors under the seat.
(c) Install the 2 bolts on the front side of the seat.
Torque: 37 N*m (377 kgf*cm, 27 ft.*lbf)
(d) Install the 2 bolts on the rear side of the seat.
Torque: 37 N*m (377 kgf*cm, 27 ft.*lbf)
2.
INSPECT AND ADJUST SEAT SLIDE ADJUSTER
LOCKS
(a) During sliding operation of the front seat, check that
the left and right adjusters move together smoothly
and lock simultaneously. If the seat adjusters do not
lock simultaneously, loosen the seat fixation bolts to
adjust the adjuster's position.
3.
INSTALL SEAT TRACK OUTER COVER LH
(a) Attach the 3 claws to install the seat track outer
cover.
4.
INSTALL SEAT TRACK INNER BRACKET COVER LH
(a) Attach the 2 claws to install the seat track bracket
cover.
5.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
B078868E02
6.
INSPECT FRONT SEAT ASSEMBLY (for Front
Passenger Side)
(a) Perform the zero point calibration and sensitivity
check (see page RS-174).
7.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
8.
CHECK SRS WARNING LIGHT
(a) Check the SRS warning light (see page RS-31).
B078867E02
SE
SE–12
SEAT – REAR SEAT ASSEMBLY
REAR SEAT ASSEMBLY
SEAT
BODY
COMPONENTS
REAR SEATBACK
ASSEMBLY RH
REAR SEATBACK HINGE
SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
REAR SEATBACK CENTER
HINGE SUB-ASSEMBLY
18.1(185, 13)
REAR SIDE SEATBACK
ASSEMBLY RH
18.1(185, 13)
42(428, 31)
36.8(375, 27)
36.8(375, 27)
REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH
REAR SEATBACK ASSEMBLY LH
36.8(375, 27)
18.1(185, 13)
SE
REAR SEATBACK HINGE SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
REAR SIDE SEATBACK
ASSEMBLY LH
REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY
REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B132599E03
SE–13
SEAT – REAR SEAT ASSEMBLY
REAR SEATBACK LOCK RELEASE BUTTON
REAR SEATBACK STOP BUTTON GROMMET
REAR SEATBACK LOCK ASSEMBLY LH
REAR SEAT HEADREST ASSEMBLY LH
REAR SEAT HEADREST SUPPORT
18.1 (185, 13)
REAR SEATBACK FRAME LH
REAR SEAT SHOULDER BELT GUIDE CENTER
REAR SEATBACK PAD LH
REAR SEATBACK COVER LH
REAR SEATBACK COVER
x5
x2
CLIP
CLIP
HOG RING
SE
REAR SEAT CUSHION COVER
HOG RING
REAR SEAT CUSHION PAD
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
B132608E03
SE–14
SEAT – REAR SEAT ASSEMBLY
REAR SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY CENTER
REAR SEAT CENTER HEADREST ASSEMBLY
REAR SEAT SHOULDER BELT COVER
REAR SEAT HEADREST ASSEMBLY RH
REAR SEAT SHOULDER BELT
GUIDE CENTER
42 (428, 31)
REAR SEAT HEADREST
SUPPORT
REAR SEAT HEADREST
SUPPORT
REAR SEAT LOCK
RELEASE BUTTON
REAR SEATBACK STOP
BUTTON GROMMET
HOG RING
18.1 (185, 13)
REAR SEATBACK COVER
x5
REAR SEATBACK FRAME RH
x4
CLIP
REAR SEATBACK LOCK ASSEMBLY RH
CLIP
SE
REAR SEATBACK PAD RH
REAR SEATBACK COVER RH
CENTER ARMREST HINGE COVER
REAR SEAT CENTER ARMREST ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
B132674E03
SEAT – REAR SEAT ASSEMBLY
SE–15
REMOVAL
A
1.
REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY
(a) Detach the seat cushion's 2 front hooks from the
vehicle body.
NOTICE:
Follow the instructions below carefully as the
cushion frame deforms easily.
(1) Choose a hook to detach first. Place your
hands near the hook as shown in the
illustration. Then lift the seat cushion to detach
the hook.
(2) Repeat for the other hook.
(b) Detach the seat cushion's rear hook.
(c) Remove the seat cushion.
2.
REMOVE REAR SEATBACK ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Open the front part of the rear No. 1 floor deck
board.
(b) Tilt the seatback down toward the front of the
vehicle.
A: 100 mm (3.94 in.)
or Less
B132600E01
(c) Remove the 2 bolts and seatback.
3.
REMOVE REAR SEATBACK ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Remove the bolt and disconnect the rear seat outer
belt floor anchor.
(b) Open the front part of the rear No. 1 floor deck
board.
(c) Tilt the seatback down toward the front of the
vehicle.
B076029E01
(d) Remove the 2 bolts and seatback.
B076029E01
4.
REMOVE REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH (See page
IR-9)
5.
REMOVE REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH (See page
IR-9)
6.
REMOVE REAR SIDE SEATBACK ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the bolt and side seatback.
7.
REMOVE REAR SIDE SEATBACK ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Remove the bolt and side seatback.
8.
REMOVE REAR SEATBACK HINGE SUB-ASSEMBLY
LH
(a) Remove the bolt and hinge.
9.
REMOVE REAR SEATBACK HINGE SUB-ASSEMBLY
RH
(a) Remove the bolt and hinge.
SE
SE–16
SEAT – REAR SEAT ASSEMBLY
10. REMOVE REAR SEATBACK CENTER HINGE SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and hinge.
B076041E01
SE
SEAT – REAR SEAT ASSEMBLY
SE–17
DISASSEMBLY
CAUTION:
Wear protective gloves. Sharp areas on the seatback
frame may injure your hands.
for Front Side
1.
REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION COVER
(a) Remove the 51 hog rings and cushion cover from
the cushion pad.
2.
REMOVE REAR SEAT HEADREST ASSEMBLY LH
3.
REMOVE REAR SEAT HEADREST ASSEMBLY RH
4.
REMOVE REAR SEAT CENTER HEADREST
ASSEMBLY
5.
REMOVE REAR SEAT CENTER ARMREST
ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a screwdriver, pry out the armrest hinge
cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
6.
REMOVE REAR SEATBACK COVER LH
(a) Remove the rear seatback lock release button.
(b) Remove the 2 screws and shoulder belt guide.
for Back Side
Hog Ring
B132607E02
Claw
B078650E01
(c) Using a screwdriver, detach the claws and remove
the seatback stop button grommet.
HINT:
In order to detach the claws of the seatback stop
button grommet, insert your hand between the
seatback frame and the seatback cover (with pad).
Claw
B133833E01
SE
SE–18
SEAT – REAR SEAT ASSEMBLY
(d) Using a screwdriver, detach the 4 claws and remove
the rear seatback cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
B078657E02
(e) Using a clip remover, remove the 7 clips.
NOTICE:
If clips are damaged during removal, replace
them.
B076036E01
(f)
Lift up the seatback cover and remove the 12 hog
rings.
(g) Detach the claws and remove the 2 headrest
supports.
(h) Remove the seatback cover (with pad) from the
seatback frame.
Hog Ring
B132603E01
(i)
Remove the 6 hog rings and seatback cover from
the seatback pad.
SE
Hog Ring
B132604E01
7.
B
A
Claw
B084817E02
REMOVE REAR SEAT BACK COVER RH
(a) Using a screwdriver, detach the 2 claws labeled A.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
(b) Pull the shoulder belt cover in the direction indicated
by the arrow in the illustration to detach the 2 claws
labeled B. Then remove the shoulder belt cover.
(c) Remove the rear seatback lock release button.
(d) Remove the 2 screws and shoulder belt guide.
SEAT – REAR SEAT ASSEMBLY
SE–19
(e) Using a screwdriver, detach the claws and remove
the seatback stop button grommet.
HINT:
In order to detach the claws of the seatback stop
button grommet, insert your hand between the
seatback frame and the seatback cover (with pad).
Claw
B076952E01
(f)
Using a screwdriver, detach the 4 claws and remove
the rear seatback cover.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
B078657E02
(g) Using a clip remover, remove the 9 clips.
NOTICE:
If clips are damaged during removal, replace
them.
B076033E01
(h) Lift up the seatback cover and remove the 14 hog
rings.
(i) Detach the claws and remove the 2 headrest
supports.
(j) Remove the seatback cover (with pad) from the
seatback frame.
Hog Ring
B132605E01
(k) Remove the 14 hog rings and seatback cover from
the seatback pad.
8.
Hog Ring
B132606E01
REMOVE REAR SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY
CENTER (See page SB-22)
SE
SE–20
SEAT – REAR SEAT ASSEMBLY
9.
REMOVE REAR SEATBACK LOCK ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and lock.
10. REMOVE REAR SEATBACK LOCK ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and lock.
B133834E01
SE
SEAT – REAR SEAT ASSEMBLY
SE–21
REASSEMBLY
CAUTION:
Wear protective gloves. Sharp areas on the seatback
frame may injure your hands.
1.
INSTALL REAR SEATBACK LOCK ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the lock with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 18.1 N*m (185 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
2.
INSTALL REAR SEATBACK LOCK ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Install the lock with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 18.1 N*m (185 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
3.
INSTALL REAR SEAT OUTER BELT ASSEMBLY
CENTER (See page SB-23)
4.
INSTALL REAR SEAT BACK COVER LH
NOTICE:
• Be careful not to damage the cover.
• When installing the hog rings, avoid wrinkling the
cover.
(a) Install the seatback cover (with pad) to the seatback
frame.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the cover.
B133834E01
Hog Ring Pliers
B050126E09
(b) Using hog ring pliers, install the seatback cover to
the seatback pad with 6 new hog rings.
(c) Install the seatback cover (with pad) to the seatback
frame.
(d) Attach the claws to install the 2 headrest supports.
Hog Ring
B132604E01
(e) Using hog ring pliers, install 12 new hog rings.
Hog Ring
B132603E01
SE
SE–22
SEAT – REAR SEAT ASSEMBLY
(f)
Install the 7 clips.
B076036E01
(g) Attach the 4 claws to install the rear seatback cover.
Claws
B078657E03
(h) Attach the claws to install the seatback stop button
grommet.
(i) Install the shoulder belt guide with the 2 screws.
(j) Install the rear seatback lock release button.
Claw
B133833E01
5.
Hog Ring Pliers
SE
INSTALL REAR SEATBACK COVER RH
NOTICE:
• Be careful not to damage the cover.
• When installing the hog rings, avoid wrinkling the
cover.
(a) Install the seatback cover (with pad) to the seatback
frame.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the cover.
B050126E09
(b) Using hog ring pliers, install the seatback cover to
the seatback pad with 14 new hog rings.
(c) Install the seatback cover (with pad) to the seatback
frame.
(d) Attach the claws to install the 2 headrest supports.
Hog Ring
B132606E01
SEAT – REAR SEAT ASSEMBLY
SE–23
(e) Using hog ring pliers, install 14 new hog rings.
Hog Ring
B132605E01
(f)
Install the 9 clips.
B076033E01
(g) Attach the 4 claws to install the rear seatback cover.
Claws
B078657E03
(h) Attach the claws to install the seatback stop button
grommet.
(i) Install the shoulder belt guide with the 2 screws.
(j) Install the rear seatback lock release button.
SE
Claw
B076952E01
(k) Attach the 4 claws to install the shoulder belt cover.
6.
INSTALL REAR SEAT CENTER ARMREST
ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the armrest with the bolt.
(b) Attach the claw to install the armrest hinge cover.
7.
INSTALL REAR SEAT HEADREST ASSEMBLY LH
8.
INSTALL REAR SEAT HEADREST ASSEMBLY RH
9.
INSTALL REAR SEAT CENTER HEADREST
ASSEMBLY
B
A
Claw
B084817E03
SE–24
SEAT – REAR SEAT ASSEMBLY
10. INSTALL REAR SEAT CUSHION COVER
(a) Using hog ring pliers, install the cushion cover to the
cushion pad with 51 new hog rings.
NOTICE:
• Be careful not to damage the cover.
• When installing the hog rings, minimize
wrinkles as much as possible.
for Front Side
for Back Side
Hog Ring
B076042E02
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL REAR SEATBACK CENTER HINGE SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Install the hinge with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 18.1 N*m (185 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
2.
INSTALL REAR SEATBACK HINGE SUB-ASSEMBLY
LH
(a) Install the hinge with the bolt.
Torque: 18.1 N*m (185 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
3.
INSTALL REAR SEATBACK HINGE SUB-ASSEMBLY
RH
(a) Install the hinge with the bolt.
Torque: 18.1 N*m (185 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
4.
INSTALL REAR SIDE SEATBACK ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the side seatback with the bolt.
5.
INSTALL REAR SIDE SEATBACK ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Install the side seatback with the bolt.
6.
INSTALL REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH (See page
IR-18)
7.
INSTALL REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH (See page
IR-18)
B076041
SE
SEAT – REAR SEAT ASSEMBLY
SE–25
8.
INSTALL REAR SEATBACK ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the seatback with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 36.8 N*m (375 kgf*cm, 27 ft.*lbf)
(b) Close the front part of the rear No. 1 floor deck
board.
(c) Return the seatback to the upright position.
9.
INSTALL REAR SEATBACK ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Install the seatback with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 36.8 N*m (375 kgf*cm, 27 ft.*lbf)
(b) Close the front part of the rear No. 1 floor deck
board.
(c) Return the seatback to the upright position.
(d) Connect the rear seat outer belt floor anchor with
the bolt.
Torque: 42 N*m (428 kgf*cm, 31 ft.*lbf)
B076029E01
B076028E01
10. INSTALL REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY
NOTICE:
When installing the seat cushion, make sure the seat
belt buckle is not under the seat cushion.
(a) Attach the seat cushion's rear hook to the center
hinge.
(b) Insert the inner belts through the slits on the seat
cushion.
SE
B132601E01
(c) Attach the seat cushion's 2 front hooks to the
vehicle body.
(d) Confirm that the seat cushion is firmly installed.
B132602
SP–1
SUSPENSION – SUSPENSION SYSTEM
SUSPENSION SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
Use the table below to help determine the cause of the
problem symptom. The potential causes of the symptoms are
listed in order of probability in the "Suspected area" column of
the table. Check each symptom by checking the suspected
areas in the order they are listed. Replace parts as
necessary.
Suspension system
Symptom
Vehicle is unstable
Bottoming
Sways/pitches
Wheels shimmy
Abnormal tire wear
Vehice pull
Suspected area
See page
1. Tires (worn or improperly inflated)
TW-3
2. Front wheel alignment
SP-2
3. Rear wheel alignment
SP-10
4. Front hub bearing
AH-4
5. Rear hub bearing
AH-10
6. Front shock absorber with coil spring
SP-14
7. Rear shock absorber with coil spring
SP-33
1. Vehicle (overloaded)
-
2. Front shock absorber with coil spring
SP-14
3. Rear shock absorber with coil spring
SP-33
1. Tire (worn or improperly inflated)
TW-3
2. Front stabilizer bar
SP-29
3. Rear stabilizer bar
SP-45
4. Front shock absorber with coil spring
SP-14
5. Rear shock absorber with coil spring
SP-33
1. Tire (worn or improperly inflated)
TW-3
2. Wheels (out of balance)
TW-3
3. Front wheel alignment
SP-2
4. Rear wheel alignment
SP-10
5. Front suspension lower No. 1 arm sub-assy
SP-20
6. Front lower ball joint assembly
SP-24
7. Rear axle beam
SP-38
8. Front shock absorber with coil spring
SP-14
9. Rear shock absorber with coil spring
SP-14
10. Front hub bearing
AH-4
11. Rear hub bearing
AH-10
1. Tire (worn or improperly inflated)
TW-3
2. Wheels (out of balance)
TW-3
3. Front wheel alignment
SP-2
4. Rear wheel alignment
SP-10
1. Tire
TW-3
2. Tire pressure (incorrect)
TW-3
3. Front wheel alignment (incorrect)
SP-2
4. Rear wheel alignment (incorrect)
SP-10
5. Brake (dragging)
-
6. Steering wheel (off center)
-
SP
SP–2
SUSPENSION – FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
ADJUSTMENT
Front:
1.
INSPECT TIRE
(a) Inspect the tires (see page TW-3).
2.
MEASURE VEHICLE HEIGHT
Standard vehicle height
Item
Front (A - B)
95 mm (3.74 in.)
Rear (D - C)
62 mm (2.44 in.)
A
B
Measuring points:
A:
Ground clearance of front wheel center
B:
Ground clearance of lower arm No. 1 set bolt
center
C:
Ground clearance of rear axle carrier bush set
bolt center
D:
Ground clearance of rear wheel center
NOTICE:
Before inspecting the wheel alignment, adjust the
vehicle height to the specified value.
HINT:
Bounce the vehicle at the corners up and down to
stabilize the suspension and inspect the vehicle height.
Rear:
D
C
F046082E03
A
D
B
Front
3.
INSPECT TOE-IN
Standard toe-in
Item
Specified Condition
Toe-in (total)
A + B: 0° +-12' (0° +-0.2°)
C - D: 0 +-2 mm (0 +-0.08 in.)
HINT:
• Measure "C - D" only when "A + B" cannot be
measured.
• If the toe-in is not within the specified range, adjust it
at the rack ends.
C
SP
Specified Condition
SA03213E02
4.
ADJUST TOE-IN
(a) Measure the thread lengths of the right and left rack
ends.
Standard difference in thread length:
1.5 mm (0.059 in.) or less
(b) Remove the rack boot set clips.
(c) Loosen the tie rod end lock nuts.
(d) Adjust the rack ends if the difference in thread
length between the right and left rack ends is not
within the specified range.
(1) Extend the shorter rack end if the measured
toe-in deviates toward the outer-side.
(2) Shorten the longer rack end if the measured
toe-in deviates toward the inner-side.
SP–3
SUSPENSION – FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
(e) Turn the right and left rack ends by an equal amount
to adjust toe-in.
HINT:
Try to adjust toe-in to the center of the specified
range.
(f)
Make sure that the lengths of the right and left rack
ends are the same.
Standard :
0 +-1 mm (0.0039 in.)
(g) Torque the tie rod end lock nuts.
Torque: 74 N*m (755 kgf*cm, 55 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Temporarily tighten the lock nut while holding
the hexagonal part of the steering rack end so
that the lock nut and the steering rack end do
not turn together. Hold the width across the flat
part of the tie rod end and tighten the lock nut.
(h) Place the boots on the seats and install the clips.
HINT:
Make sure that the boots are not twisted.
(i) Perform VSC system calibration (see page BC-21).
Difference
Lock Nut
F046085E01
5.
Front
A B
B A
Front
INSPECT WHEEL ANGLE
(a) Fully turn the steering wheel to the left and right and
measure the turning angle.
Standard wheel turning angle
Item
Specified Condition
Inside wheel
40° 35' +-2° (40.58° +-2°)
Outside wheel:
Reference
34° 15' (34.25°)
A: Inside
If the right and left inside wheel angles differ from
the specified range, check the right and left rack end
lengths.
B: Outside
C118572E01
6.
Alignment
Tester
Gauge
Z003382E08
INSPECT CAMBER, CASTER AND STEERING AXIS
INCLINATION
(a) Put the front wheel on the center of the alignment
tester.
(b) Remove the center ornament.
(c) Install the camber-caster-steering axis inclination
gauge at the center of the axle hub or drive shaft.
(d) Inspect the camber, caster and steering axis
inclination.
Standard camber, caster and steering axis
inclination
Item
Specified Condition
Camber
Right-left error
-0° 35' +-45' (-0.58° +-0.75°)
45' (0.75°) or less
Caster
Right-left error
3° 10' +-45' (3.17° +-0.75°)
45' (0.75°) or less
SP
SP–4
SUSPENSION – FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
Item
Specified Condition
Steering axis inclination
Right-left error
12° 35' +-45' (12.58° +-0.75°)
45' (0.75°) or less
NOTICE:
• Inspect with an empty vehicle (without the
spare tire or tools).
• The maximum tolerance of the right and left
difference for the camber and caster is 45' or
less.
(e) Remove the camber-caster-steering axis inclination
gauge and attachment.
(f) Install the center ornament.
If the caster and steering axis inclination are not
within the specified values after the camber has
been correctly adjusted, recheck the suspension
parts for damage and/or wear.
7.
F046086E01
-
+
F047225E02
SP
1
2
F047338E01
ADJUST CAMBER
NOTICE:
Inspect toe-in after the camber has been adjusted.
(a) Remove the front wheel.
(b) Remove the 2 nuts on the lower side of the shock
absorber.
NOTICE:
When removing the nut, stop the bolt from rotating
and loosen the nut.
(c) Clean the installation surfaces of the shock absorber
and the steering knuckle.
(d) Temporarily install the 2 nuts.
(e) Fully push or pull the front axle hub in the direction of
the required adjustment.
(f) Tighten the nuts.
Torque: 153 N*m (1,560 kgf*cm, 113 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Keep the bolts from rotating and torque the nuts.
(g) Install the front wheel.
Torque: 103 N*m (1,050 kgf*cm, 76 ft.*lbf)
(h) Check the camber.
If the measured value is not within the specified range,
calculate the required adjustment amount using the
formula below.
Camber adjustment amount:
Center of the specified range - Measured value
Check the installed bolt combination. Select appropriate
bolts from the table below to adjust the camber to within
the specified range.
Standard selection table
Item
Selection Table
Move the axle toward (+) in step (e)
Refer to table (1) (Move the axle
toward positive side)
Move the axle toward (-) in step (e)
Refer to table (2) (Move the axle
toward negative side)
SUSPENSION – FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
SP–5
(i) Measure the camber with the bolts currently installed
and check the amount of looseness from the specified
range. (Ex: The measured value is - 1°35')
(j) Determine whether the direction of the required
adjustment is toward the positive or negative side. (Ex:
Refer to table (1) (Move the axle toward positive side))
(k) Check the required adjustment amount from the
measured value. (Table (1), Table (2)) (Ex: Select "Adjust
value: 0°45' to 1°00")
(l) Check the currently installed bolt combination. (Ex: "
Installed bolt 1: no dot; Installed bolt 2: 2 dots")
(m) Select the adjusting bolts. (Ex: "Selected Bolt
Combination" results in F for installed bolt 1: 3 dots;
Installed bolt 2: 3 dots)
(n) Measure the alignment again and check that it is
within the specified range. (Ex: Measured value is within
-0° 35' +-45')
SP
SP–6
SUSPENSION – FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
Table (1) (Move the axle toward positive side)
Selected Bolt Combination
SP
Bolt Distinguishing Mark
C125767E02
The body and suspension may be damaged if the
camber is not correctly adjusted according to the above
table.
SUSPENSION – FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
SP–7
NOTICE:
Replace the nut with a new one when replacing the
bolt.
(o) Repeat the steps mentioned above. At step (b),
replace 1 or 2 selected bolts.
HINT:
Replace 1 bolt at a time when replacing 2 bolts.
SP
SP–8
SUSPENSION – FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
Table (2) (Move the axle toward negative side)
Selected Bolt Combination
SP
Bolt Distinguishing Mark
C125768E02
The body and suspension may be damaged if the
camber is not correctly adjusted according to the above
table.
(p) Repeat the steps mentioned above. At step (b),
replace 1 or 2 selected bolts.
SUSPENSION – FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
SP–9
NOTICE:
Replace the nut with a new one when replacing the
bolt.
HINT:
Replace 1 bolt at a time when replacing 2 bolts.
SP
SP–10
SUSPENSION – REAR WHEEL ALIGNMENT
REAR WHEEL ALIGNMENT
INSPECTION
A
D
B
Front
1.
INSPECT TIRE
(a) Inspect the tires (see page TW-3).
2.
MEASURE VEHICLE HEIGHT
(a) Measure the vehicle height (see page SP-2).
3.
INSPECT TOE-IN
Standard toe-in
Item
Specified Condition
Toe-in
(total)
A + B: 0° 18' +-15' (0.30° +-0.25°)
C - D: 3.0 +-2.5 mm (0.12 +-0.10 in.)
HINT:
• Measure "C - D" only when "A + B'" cannot be
measured.
• If the toe-in is not within the specified range, inspect
the suspension parts for damage and/or wear, and
replace them if necessary.
C
SA03213E02
4.
INSPECT CAMBER
(a) Install the camber-caster-kingpin gauge or set the
vehicle on a wheel alignment tester.
(b) Inspect the camber.
Standard camber
Item
Specified Condition
Camber
Right-left error
-1° 30' +-30' (-1.50 +-0.5°)
30' (0.5°) or less
HINT:
Camber is not adjustable. If the measurement is not
within the specified range, inspect the suspension
parts for damage and/or wear, and replace them if
necessary.
SP
SP–11
SUSPENSION – FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL SPRING
FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL SPRING
SUSPENSION & AXLE
COMPONENTS
FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL SPRING
39 (398, 29)
FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY LH
FRONT SUSPENSION SUPPORT
DUST COVER LH
47 (479, 35)
FRONT SUSPENSION
SUPPORT SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
FRONT SUSPENSION
SUPPORT LH DUST SEAL
FRONT COIL SPRING
SEAT UPPER LH
FRONT COIL SPRING
INSULATOR UPPER LH
74 (755, 55)
153 (1,560, 113)
19 (192, 14)
FRONT SPEED SENSOR LH
SP
FRONT COIL SPRING LH
FRONT COIL SPRING INSULATOR LOWER LH
FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
FRONT SPRING
BUMPER LH
Non-reusable part
C129239E02
SP–12
SUSPENSION – FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL SPRING
REMOVAL
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
2.
REMOVE FRONT WIPER ARM HEAD CAP
3.
REMOVE FRONT WIPER ARM LH (See page WW-13)
4.
REMOVE FRONT WIPER ARM RH (See page WW-13)
5.
REMOVE HOOD TO COWL TOP SEAL (See page
WW-13)
6.
REMOVE COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER LH (See
page WW-13)
7.
REMOVE COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER RH (See
page WW-13)
8.
REMOVE WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR AND LINK
(See page WW-13)
9.
DISCONNECT FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY
(a) Place a wooden block on a jack, and support the
front suspension lower No. 1 arm with the jack.
(b) Remove the nut and separate the front stabilizer link
from the shock absorber with coil spring.
HINT:
Use a 6 mm hexagon wrench to hold the stud if the
ball joint turns together with the nut.
F046088E01
10. REMOVE FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL
SPRING
(a) Remove the bolt and disconnect the front flexible
hose No. 1 and speed sensor front LH wire harness.
NOTICE:
Be sure to completely disconnect the speed
sensor front LH from the front shock absorber.
SP
C080880E01
(b) Remove the 2 nuts on the lower side of the front
shock absorber with coil spring.
NOTICE:
Keep the bolts inserted.
F046086E01
SUSPENSION – FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL SPRING
SP–13
(c) Remove the 3 nuts.
(d) Lower the jack slowly. Remove the 2 bolts on the
lower side and the front shock absorber with coil
spring.
NOTICE:
Ensure that the speed sensor front LH is
completely disconnected from the front shock
absorber with coil spring.
F046083E01
DISASSEMBLY
1.
FIX FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL SPRING
(a) Secure the front shock absorber with coil spring in a
vise by clamping onto a double nutted bolt affixed to
the bracket at the bottom of the absorber, as shown
in the illustration to the left.
2.
REMOVE FRONT SUPPORT TO FRONT SHOCK
ABSORBER LH NUT
(a) Attach SST to the coil spring so that the upper and
lower hooks of the installed area are as wide as
possible.
SST 09727-30021 (09727-00010, 09727-00021,
09727-00031)
(b) Fully compress the coil spring.
NOTICE:
Do not use an impact wrench. It will damage
SST.
HINT:
The coil spring can also be installed/removed using
the hydraulic spring compressor.
(c) Remove the front suspension support dust cover.
40 mm
(1.57 in.)
F047339E02
SST
F047340E01
(d) Secure the front coil spring seat upper with SST and
remove the front suspension support to front shock
absorber LH nut.
SST 09729-22031
SST
F047341E01
3.
REMOVE FRONT SUSPENSION SUPPORT SUBASSEMBLY LH
4.
REMOVE FRONT SUSPENSION SUPPORT LH DUST
SEAL
5.
REMOVE FRONT COIL SPRING SEAT UPPER LH
6.
REMOVE FRONT COIL SPRING INSULATOR UPPER
LH
7.
REMOVE FRONT COIL SPRING LH
8.
REMOVE FRONT SPRING BUMPER LH
SP
SP–14
SUSPENSION – FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL SPRING
9.
REMOVE FRONT COIL SPRING INSULATOR LOWER
LH
10. REMOVE FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY
LH
INSPECTION
1.
C066739E01
SP
INSPECT FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY
LH
(a) Compress and extend the shock absorber rod 4 or
more times. Check that there is no abnormal
resistance or sound.
If there is any abnormality, replace the shock
absorber front LH with a new one.
NOTICE:
When disposing of the shock absorber, see
DISPOSAL (see page SP-17).
SUSPENSION – FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL SPRING
SP–15
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY LH
2.
INSTALL FRONT COIL SPRING INSULATOR LOWER
LH
(a) Install the front coil spring insulator lower to the front
shock absorber so that both recessed parts are
aligned.
3.
INSTALL FRONT SPRING BUMPER LH
4.
INSTALL FRONT COIL SPRING LH
(a) Using SST, compress the coil spring.
SST 09727-30021 (09727-00010, 09727-00021,
09727-00031)
NOTICE:
Do not use an impact wrench. It will damage
SST.
HINT:
The coil spring can also be installed/removed using
the hydraulic spring compressor.
(b) Fit the lower end of the front coil spring LH into the
recessed part of the spring lower seat.
HINT:
Install the spring with the smaller diameter on top.
5.
INSTALL FRONT COIL SPRING INSULATOR UPPER
LH
(a) Install the front coil spring insulator upper to the
front shock absorber with the protruding part facing
the outside of the vehicle.
6.
INSTALL FRONT COIL SPRING SEAT UPPER LH
(a) Install the front coil spring seat upper with the
recess facing the outside of the vehicle.
NOTICE:
• Fit the protruding part of the front coil spring
insulator upper LH to the recess of the front
coil spring seat upper LH.
• Ensure that the width across the flat parts of
the piston rod and the front coil spring seat
upper LH are fitted.
7.
INSTALL FRONT SUSPENSION SUPPORT LH DUST
SEAL
8.
INSTALL FRONT SUSPENSION SUPPORT SUBASSEMBLY LH
Align
F047342E01
SST
F047343E01
Outside
Outside
F047344E01
Outside
F047346E01
SP
SP–16
SUSPENSION – FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL SPRING
9.
SST
F047341E01
INSTALL FRONT SUPPORT TO FRONT SHOCK
ABSORBER LH NUT
(a) Secure the front coil spring seat upper with SST and
tighten it with a new nut.
Torque: 47 N*m (479 kgf*cm, 35 ft.*lbf)
(b) Release SST while aligning the protruding part of
the front coil spring insulator upper, the recess of
the spring front coil spring seat upper and the shock
absorber lower bracket, and then remove SST from
the coil spring.
SST 09729-22031
NOTICE:
Do not use an impact wrench when removing
SST.
(c) Apply No. 2 MP grease to the parts indicated in the
illustration and install the front suspension support
dust cover.
No. 2 MP grease
F047345E01
SP
SUSPENSION – FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL SPRING
SP–17
INSTALLATION
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
F046083E01
INSTALL FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL
SPRING
(a) Insert the 2 bolts from the front side of the vehicle
and install the front shock absorber with coil spring
to the steering knuckle.
(b) Place a wooden block between the front shock
absorber with coil spring and a jack. Slowly raise the
jack and install the front shock absorber with coil
spring (upper side) to the vehicle.
(c) Install the front shock absorber with coil spring
(upper side) with the 3 nuts.
Torque: 39 N*m (398 kgf*cm, 29 ft.*lbf)
(d) Install the front shock absorber with coil spring to
the steering knuckle with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 153 N*m (1,560 kgf*cm, 113 ft.*lbf)
F046086E01
(e) Connect the front flexible hose No. 1 and the speed
sensor front LH to the shock absorber with the bolt.
Torque: 19 N*m (192 kgf*cm, 14 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Do not twist the speed sensor front while
installing.
C080880E01
2.
CONNECT FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Connect the front stabilizer link to the front shock
absorber with coil spring with the nut.
Torque: 74 N*m (755 kgf*cm, 55 ft.*lbf)
HINT:
Use a 6 mm hexagon wrench to hold the stud if the
ball joint turns together with the nut.
3.
INSTALL WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR AND LINK
(See page WW-16)
4.
INSTALL COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER LH (See
page WW-17)
5.
INSTALL COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER RH (See
page WW-17)
F046088E01
SP
SP–18
SUSPENSION – FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL SPRING
6.
INSTALL HOOD TO COWL TOP SEAL (See page WW17)
7.
INSTALL FRONT WIPER ARM LH (See page WW-16)
8.
INSTALL FRONT WIPER ARM RH (See page WW-16)
9.
INSTALL FRONT WIPER ARM HEAD CAP
10. INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
Torque: 103 N*m (1,050 kgf*cm, 76 ft.*lbf)
11. INSPECT AND ADJUST FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
(a) Inspect and adjust the front wheel alignment (see
page SP-2).
SP
SUSPENSION – FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL SPRING
SP–19
DISPOSAL
HINT:
Dispose of the RH side following the same procedures as the
LH side.
1.
A
B
F047347E01
DISPOSE OF FRONT SHOCK ABSORBER
ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Fully extend the shock absorber rod.
(b) Using a drill, make a hole in the cylinder between A
and B shown in the illustration to discharge the gas
inside.
CAUTION:
Be careful when drilling because shards of
metal may fly about, so always use the proper
safety equipment.
NOTICE:
The gas is colorless, odorless and nonpoisonous.
SP
SP–18
SUSPENSION – FRONT SUSPENSION LOWER NO. 1 ARM
FRONT SUSPENSION LOWER NO. 1 ARM
SUSPENSION & AXLE
COMPONENTS
EXHAUST PIPE GASKET
43 (438, 32)
FRONT EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY
43 (438, 32)
43 (438, 32)
43 (438, 32)
EXHAUST PIPE GASKET
FRONT FLOOR PANEL BRACE
NO. 2 TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY
30 (306, 22)
FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY LH
74 (755, 55)
74 (755, 55)
CLIP
SP
49 (500, 36)
137 (1,400, 101)
FRONT SUSPENSION
CROSSMEMBER SUB-ASSEMBLY
137 (1,400, 101)
FRONT SUSPENSION LOWER NO. 1 ARM SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
89 (908, 66)
C129271E01
SUSPENSION – FRONT SUSPENSION LOWER NO. 1 ARM
SP–19
REMOVAL
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
PLACE FRONT WHEELS FACING STRAIGHT AHEAD
2.
REMOVE COLUMN HOLE COVER SILENCER SHEET
(See page SR-10)
3.
DISCONNECT STEERING SLIDING YOKE SUBASSEMBLY (See page PS-50)
4.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
5.
REMOVE FRONT EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY (See
page EX-2)
6.
REMOVE FRONT AXLE HUB NUT LH (See page DS5)
7.
REMOVE FRONT AXLE HUB NUT RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
8.
DISCONNECT NO. 2 TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY
(See page DS-6)
9.
DISCONNECT NO. 1 TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY
(See page PS-50)
10. DISCONNECT FRONT SUSPENSION LOWER NO. 1
ARM SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the bolt and 2 nuts.
(b) Lower the front suspension lower No. 1 arm and
disconnect it from the front lower ball joint.
F041742E01
11. REMOVE FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the nuts and disconnect the stabilizer link
LH and RH from the front shock absorber with coil
spring.
HINT:
Use a 6 mm hexagon wrench to hold the stud if the
ball joint turns together with the nut.
F046088E01
12. DISCONNECT FRONT SUSPENSION LOWER NO. 1
ARM SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
HINT:
Remove the RH side following the same procedures as
the LH side.
13. REMOVE FRONT AXLE ASSEMBLY LH (See page
AH-6)
SP
SP–20
SUSPENSION – FRONT SUSPENSION LOWER NO. 1 ARM
14. REMOVE FRONT AXLE ASSEMBLY RH
HINT:
Remove the RH side following the same procedures as
the LH side.
15. REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY LH (See
page DS-7)
16. REMOVE FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY RH (See
page DS-7)
17. DISCONNECT FRONT SUSPENSION
CROSSMEMBER SUB-ASSEMBLY
18. REMOVE FRONT SUSPENSION LOWER NO. 1 ARM
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the 2 bolts, nut and front suspension lower
No. 1 arm.
NOTICE:
Keep the nut from rotating and loosen the bolt.
C095318E01
SP
SUSPENSION – FRONT SUSPENSION LOWER NO. 1 ARM
SP–21
INSTALLATION
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
C095318E01
1.
TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN FRONT SUSPENSION
LOWER NO. 1 ARM SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the front suspension lower No. 1 arm to the
suspension crossmember and temporarily tighten
the front suspension lower No. 1 arm with the 2
bolts and nut.
2.
CONNECT FRONT SUSPENSION CROSSMEMBER
SUB-ASSEMBLY
3.
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY LH (See
page DS-15)
4.
INSTALL FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY RH (See
page DS-15)
5.
INSTALL FRONT AXLE ASSEMBLY LH (See page AH6)
6.
INSTALL FRONT AXLE ASSEMBLY RH
HINT:
Install the RH side following the same procedures as the
LH side.
7.
INSTALL FRONT SUSPENSION LOWER NO. 1 ARM
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the front suspension lower No. 1 arm to the
front lower ball joint with the bolt and 2 nuts.
Torque: 89 N*m (908 kgf*cm, 66 ft.*lbf)
8.
INSTALL FRONT SUSPENSION LOWER NO. 1 ARM
SUB-ASSEMBLY RH
HINT:
Install the RH side following the same procedures as the
LH side.
9.
INSTALL FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY
(a) Connect the front stabilizer link LH and RH to the
front shock absorber with coil spring with the nuts.
Torque: 74 N*m (755 kgf*cm, 55 ft.*lbf)
HINT:
Use a 6 mm hexagon wrench to hold the stud if the
ball joint turns together with the nut.
F041742E01
10. INSTALL NO. 2 TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY (See
page PS-55)
F046088E01
11. INSTALL NO. 1 TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY (See
page PS-50)
12. INSTALL FRONT AXLE HUB NUT LH (See page AH-7)
13. INSTALL FRONT AXLE HUB NUT RH
HINT:
Install the RH side following the same procedures as the
LH side.
SP
SP–22
SUSPENSION – FRONT SUSPENSION LOWER NO. 1 ARM
14. INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
Torque: 103 N*m (1,050 kgf*cm, 76 ft.*lbf)
15. INSTALL FRONT EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY (See
page EX-3)
16. STABILIZE SUSPENSION
(a) Lower the vehicle and bounce it up and down
several times to stabilize the front suspension.
17. CONNECT STEERING SLIDING YOKE SUBASSEMBLY (See page PS-56)
18. INSTALL COLUMN HOLE COVER SILENCER SHEET
19. FULLY TIGHTEN FRONT SUSPENSION LOWER NO.
1 ARM SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Fully tighten the 2 bolts.
Torque: 137 N*m (1,400 kgf*cm, 101 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
• Keep the nut from rotating while tightening
the rear-side bolt.
• Lower the tires to the ground using a 4-post
lift.
C087403E01
SP
20. INSPECT AND ADJUST FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
(a) Inspect and adjust the front wheel alignment (see
page SP-2).
SP–22
SUSPENSION – FRONT LOWER BALL JOINT
FRONT LOWER BALL JOINT
SUSPENSION & AXLE
COMPONENTS
FRONT NO. 1 WHEEL BEARING
DUST DEFLECTOR LH
216 (2,200, 159)
8.0 (82, 71 in.*lbf)
FRONT DRIVE SHAFT ASSEMBLY
FRONT SPEED SENSOR LH
CLIP
49 (500, 36)
109 (1,114, 81)
CLIP
FRONT DISC BRAKE
CALIPER ASSEMBLY LH
71 (724, 52)
SP
FRONT SUSPENSION NO. 1 ARM
LOWER SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
NO. 2 TIE ROD
END SUB-ASSEMBLY
FRONT DISC
216 (2,200, 159)
FRONT AXLE HUB NUT LH
89 (809, 66)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
FRONT LOWER BALL JOINT ASSEMBLY
Non-reusable part
C129240E01
SUSPENSION – FRONT LOWER BALL JOINT
SP–23
REMOVAL
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
C054719E03
C080293E01
Turn
SST
F046084E01
1.
INSPECT FRONT LOWER BALL JOINT ASSEMBLY
LH
(a) Jack up the front part of the vehicle.
(b) Move the front suspension lower No. 1 arm up and
down to check vertical looseness of the lower ball
joint front.
HINT:
Wrap a cloth around the wooden block to prevent
damage to the bolt and nuts.
2.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
3.
REMOVE FRONT AXLE HUB NUT LH (See page DS5)
4.
DISCONNECT FRONT SPEED SENSOR LH (See page
BC-218)
5.
DISCONNECT FRONT DISC BRAKE CALIPER
ASSEMBLY LH (See page BR-40)
6.
REMOVE FRONT DISC (See page BR-42)
7.
DISCONNECT NO. 2 TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY
(See page DS-6)
8.
DISCONNECT FRONT SUSPENSION LOWER NO. 1
ARM SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the bolt and 2 nuts.
(b) Lower the front suspension lower No. 1 arm and
disconnect if from the front lower ball joint.
9.
REMOVE FRONT AXLE ASSEMBLY LH (See page
AH-6)
10. REMOVE FRONT NO. 1 WHEEL BEARING DUST
DEFLECTOR LH (See page AH-5)
11. REMOVE FRONT LOWER BALL JOINT ASSEMBLY
LH
(a) Remove the clip and the castle nuts.
(b) Using SST, remove the lower ball joint front.
SST 09611-36020
NOTICE:
• Do not damage the steering knuckle.
• Securely hang SST to the spacer of the
steering knuckle.
• Replace the steering knuckle with a new one
if the spacer comes off the steering knuckle.
SP
SP–24
SUSPENSION – FRONT LOWER BALL JOINT
INSPECTION
1.
ZX01712E01
SP
INSPECT FRONT LOWER BALL JOINT ASSEMBLY
LH
(a) Flip the ball joint stud back and forth 5 times as
shown in the illustration before installing the nut.
(b) Use a torque wrench to turn the nut continuously at
a rate of 3 to 5 seconds per turn. Take the torque
reading on the fifth turn.
Torque: 0.98 to 4.90 N*m (10 to 50 kgf*cm, 8.7 to
43 in.*lbf)
(c) Check the dust boots for cracks or grease leakage.
If the value is not within the specified range, replace
the lower ball joint with a new one.
SUSPENSION – FRONT LOWER BALL JOINT
SP–25
INSTALLATION
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
C080293E01
1.
INSTALL FRONT LOWER BALL JOINT ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the lower ball joint front LH to the steering
knuckle with the castle nuts.
NOTICE:
Ensure that the thread and taper are free of oil,
etc.
Torque: 71 N*m (724 kgf*cm, 52 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Further tighten the nut up to 60° if the holes for
the cotter pin are not aligned.
(b) Install a new clip to the steering knuckle.
2.
INSTALL FRONT NO. 1 WHEEL BEARING DUST
DEFLECTOR LH (See page AH-6)
3.
INSTALL FRONT AXLE ASSEMBLY LH (See page AH6)
4.
CONNECT FRONT SUSPENSION LOWER NO. 1 ARM
SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Lower the front suspension lower No. 1 arm and
install the lower ball joint front to the front
suspension lower No. 1 arm with the bolt and 2 nuts.
Torque: 89 N*m (908 kgf*cm, 66 ft.*lbf)
5.
CONNECT NO. 2 TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY (See
page PS-55)
6.
INSTALL FRONT DISC (See page BR-43)
7.
CONNECT FRONT DISC BRAKE CALIPER
ASSEMBLY LH (See page BR-45)
8.
INSTALL FRONT SPEED SENSOR LH (See page BC218)
9.
INSTALL FRONT AXLE HUB NUT LH (See page AH-7)
10. INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
Torque: 103 N*m (1,050 kgf*cm, 76 ft.*lbf)
11. INSPECT AND ADJUST FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
(a) Inspect and adjust the front wheel alignment (see
page SP-2).
12. CHECK SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL
(a) Check the speed sensor signal (see page BC-37).
SP
SP–26
SUSPENSION – FRONT STABILIZER BAR
FRONT STABILIZER BAR
SUSPENSION & AXLE
COMPONENTS
FRONT EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY
EXHAUST PIPE GASKET
43 (438, 32)
43 (438, 32)
43 (438, 32)
EXHAUST PIPE GASKET
43 (438, 32)
FLOOR PANEL BRACE FRONT
SP
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
43 (438, 32)
Non-reusable part
C129272E01
SP–27
SUSPENSION – FRONT STABILIZER BAR
58 (591, 43)
58 (591, 43)
19 (194, 14)
FRONT NO. 1 STABILIZER
BRACKET RH
FRONT NO. 1 STABILIZER
BRACKET LH
FRONT NO. 1
STABILIZER BAR BUSH
CLIP
74 (755, 55)
FRONT STABILIZER
LINK ASSEMBLY RH
FRONT STABILIZER BAR
FRONT STABILIZER
LINK ASSEMBLY LH
49 (500, 36)
74 (755, 55)
SP
157 (1,600, 116)
113 (1,150, 83)
FRONT SUSPENSION
CROSSMEMBER SUB-ASSEMBLY
113 (1,150, 83)
157 (1,600, 116)
137 (1,400, 101)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
C129273E01
SP–28
SUSPENSION – FRONT STABILIZER BAR
REMOVAL
1.
PLACE FRONT WHEELS FACING STRAIGHT AHEAD
2.
REMOVE COLUMN HOLE COVER SILENCER SHEET
(See page SR-10)
3.
DISCONNECT STEERING SLIDING YOKE SUBASSEMBLY (See page PS-50)
4.
DISCONNECT NO. 1 STEERING COLUMN HOLE
COVER SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page PS-50)
5.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
6.
REMOVE FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the 2 nuts and front stabilizer link LH.
HINT:
Use a 6 mm hexagon wrench to hold the stud if the
ball joint turns together with the nut.
7.
DISCONNECT NO. 2 TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY
(See page DS-6)
8.
DISCONNECT NO. 1 TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY
(See page PS-50)
9.
REMOVE FLOOR PANEL BRACE FRONT (See page
EX-2)
C080890E01
10. REMOVE FRONT EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY (See
page EX-2)
11. DISCONNECT FRONT NO. 1 STABILIZER BRACKET
LH
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and the No. 1 stabilizer bracket
from the front suspension crossmember.
12. DISCONNECT FRONT NO. 1 STABILIZER BRACKET
RH
HINT:
Remove the RH side following the same procedures as
the LH side.
13. REMOVE STEERING INTERMEDIATE SHAFT (See
page PS-51)
SP
14. REMOVE NO. 1 STEERING COLUMN HOLE COVER
SUB-ASSEMBLY
15. REMOVE STEERING GEAR ASSEMBLY (See page
PS-51)
16. REMOVE FRONT NO. 1 STABILIZER BAR BUSH
(a) Remove the 2 front No. 1 stabilizer bar bushes from
the stabilizer bar.
17. REMOVE FRONT STABILIZER BAR
(a) Remove the front stabilizer bar from the right side of
the vehicle.
SUSPENSION – FRONT STABILIZER BAR
SP–29
INSPECTION
1.
C066721E01
INSPECT FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY
(a) Flip the ball joint stud back and forth 5 times as
shown in the illustration before installing the nut.
(b) Use a torque wrench to turn the nut continuously at
a rate of 2 to 4 seconds per turn. Take the torque
reading on the fifth turn.
Torque: 0.05 to 1.96 N*m (0.5 to 20 kgf*cm, 0.4 to
17.4 in.*lbf)
(c) Check the dust cover for cracks or grease leakage.
If the value is not within the specified range, replace
the front stabilizer link with a new one.
SP
SP–30
SUSPENSION – FRONT STABILIZER BAR
INSTALLATION
Front
Bush Stopper
1.
INSTALL FRONT STABILIZER BAR
(a) Insert the front stabilizer bar from the right side of
the vehicle.
2.
INSTALL FRONT NO. 1 STABILIZER BAR BUSH
(a) Install the bush to the outer side of the bush stopper
on the stabilizer bar.
NOTICE:
• Place the cutout of the stabilizer bush facing
the rear side.
• Ensure the right and left deviation of the
stabilizer bar is 5 mm (0.20 in.) or less.
3.
INSTALL STEERING GEAR ASSEMBLY (See page
PS-54)
4.
INSTALL NO. 1 STEERING COLUMN HOLE COVER
SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page PS-55)
5.
INSTALL STEERING INTERMEDIATE SHAFT (See
page PS-55)
6.
CONNECT FRONT NO. 1 STABILIZER BRACKET LH
(a) Install the No. 1 stabilizer bracket the front
suspension crossmember with the 2 bolts.
Torque: 19 N*m (194 kgf*cm, 14 ft.*lbf)
7.
CONNECT FRONT NO. 1 STABILIZER BRACKET RH
HINT:
Install the RH side following the same procedures as the
LH side.
8.
INSTALL FRONT EXHAUST PIPE ASSEMBLY (See
page EX-3)
9.
INSTALL FLOOR PANEL BRACE FRONT (See page
EX-4)
F047348E01
10. INSTALL FRONT STABILIZER LINK ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the front stabilizer link LH with the 2 nuts.
Torque: 74 N*m (755 kgf*cm, 55 ft.*lbf)
HINT:
Use a 6 mm hexagon wrench to hold the stud if the
ball joint turns together with the nut.
SP
11. INSTALL NO. 2 TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY (See
page PS-55)
C080890E01
12. INSTALL NO. 1 TIE ROD END SUB-ASSEMBLY (See
page DS-16)
13. INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
Torque: 103 N*m (1,050 kgf*cm, 76 ft.*lbf)
14. INSPECT AND ADJUST FRONT WHEEL ALIGNMENT
(a) Inspect and adjust the front wheel alignment (see
page SP-2).
SUSPENSION – REAR SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL SPRING
SP–31
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL SPRING
SUSPENSION & AXLE
COMPONENTS
56 (571, 41)
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER NO. 1 CUSHION WASHER
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER NO. 1 CUSHION
80 (816, 59)
REAR SPRING FRONT BRACKET SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
REAR SUSPENSION
SUPPORT ASSEMBLY LH
REAR COIL SPRING
INSULATOR UPPER LH
80 (816, 59)
REAR NO. 1 SPRING BUMPER LH
REAR COIL SPRING LH
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY LH
SPACER
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
80 (816, 59)
SP
REAR AXLE BEAM ASSEMBLY
SKID CONTROL SENSOR WIRE
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
C129274E01
SP–32
SUSPENSION – REAR SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL SPRING
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD
2.
REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX
3.
REMOVE REAR DECK TRIM COVER (See page IR-10)
4.
REMOVE TONNEAU COVER ASSEMBLY
5.
REMOVE REAR SEATBACK ASSEMBLY LH (See
page SE-15)
6.
REMOVE REAR NO. 1 FLOOR BOARD (See page IR10)
7.
REMOVE REAR SIDE SEATBACK FRAME LH (See
page IR-9)
8.
REMOVE REAR NO. 4 FLOOR BOARD
9.
REMOVE DECK FLOOR BOX LH
10. REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY LH
(See page IR-11)
11. REMOVE BATTERY CARRIER BRACKET (See page
HB-91)
12. REMOVE REAR WHEEL
13. REMOVE REAR SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL
SPRING
(a) Support the rear axle beam with a jack. Insert a
wooden block between the jack and the rear axle
beam to prevent damage.
Wooden Block
F040125E02
(b) Remove the 2 nuts from the rear shock absorber
with coil spring (upper side).
(c) Remove the rear shock absorber with coil spring
(upper side) bolt from the under-side of the vehicle.
SP
G027360E01
SUSPENSION – REAR SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL SPRING
SP–33
(d) Remove the nut and spacer from the rear shock
absorber with coil spring (lower side).
(e) Remove the rear shock absorber with coil spring
while slowly lowering the jack.
NOTICE:
Seat the jack so that no extra load is placed on
the shock absorber on the opposite side of the
vehicle.
C067565E01
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE REAR SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Use a 6 mm socket hexagon wrench to secure the
piston rod of the shock absorber and loosen the nut.
NOTICE:
• Do not remove the nut.
• Sufficiently insert the hexagon wrench.
F040127E01
(b) Attach SST to the coil spring so that the upper and
lower hooks of the installed area are as wide as
possible.
SST 09727-30021 (09727-00010, 09727-00021,
09727-00031)
(c) Compress the coil spring until it moves freely.
NOTICE:
Do not use an impact wrench. It will damage
SST.
(d) Remove the nut.
SST
F040126E01
(e) Remove the No. 1 cushion washer, No. 1 cushion,
rear spring front bracket, rear suspension support,
rear coil spring insulator upper and rear No. 1 spring
bumper.
HINT:
The shock absorber can be replaced without
removing the No. 1 cushion and rear suspension
support from the rear spring front bracket.
(f) Release SST and remove it from the coil spring
after removing the coil spring from the shock
absorber.
No. 1
Cushion
Rear
Suspension
Support
Assembly
F047405E01
INSPECTION
1.
C067568E01
INSPECT REAR SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Compress and extend the shock absorber rod, and
check that there is no abnormal resistance or
unusual sound.
If there is any abnormality, replace the shock
absorber with a new one.
NOTICE:
When disposing of the shock absorber, see
DISPOSAL (see page SP-36).
SP
SP–34
SUSPENSION – REAR SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL SPRING
REASSEMBLY
1.
SST
F040128E02
INSTALL REAR SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Using SST, compress the coil spring.
SST 09727-30021 (09727-00010, 09727-00021,
09727-00031)
NOTICE:
Do not use an impact wrench. It will damage
SST.
HINT:
The coil spring can also be installed/removed using
the hydraulic spring compressor.
(b) Fit the coil spring end into the recessed part of the
shock absorber assy lower seat.
(c) Fit the rear coil spring insulator upper to the rear
spring front bracket.
End
Recessed Part
F040129E02
(d) Install the rear No. 1 spring bumper, rear
suspension support, rear spring front bracket, No. 1
cushion and No. 1 cushion washer.
NOTICE:
• Install the rear spring front bracket so that it
is aligned with the shock absorber lower
bush, as shown in the illustration.
• Install the No. 1 cushion washer with the
protruding portion facing down.
Front
80.6°
F040274E01
SP
F040130E01
(e) Use a 6 mm socket hexagon wrench to fix the shock
absorber piston rod and tighten the nut.
Torque: 56 N*m (571 kgf*cm, 41 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Sufficiently insert the hexagon wrench.
(f) Release SST and remove it from the coil spring.
NOTICE:
• Do not use an impact wrench. It will damage
SST.
• Remove SST while confirming the direction of
the rear spring front bracket.
SUSPENSION – REAR SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL SPRING
SP–35
INSTALLATION
1.
C067565E01
INSTALL REAR SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL
SPRING
(a) Install the rear shock absorber with coil spring to the
rear axle beam. Place the spacer and temporarily
tighten the nut.
(b) Install the rear shock absorber with coil spring
(upper side) to the vehicle by slowly raising the rear
axle beam on a jack. Insert a wooden block
between the jack and the rear axle beam to prevent
damage.
NOTICE:
• Do not raise the rear axle beam more than
necessary.
• Securely insert the rear spring front bracket
stud bolt into the vehicle.
(c) Tighten the bolt and 2 nuts of the rear shock
absorber with coil spring (upper side).
Torque: 80 N*m (816 kgf*cm, 59 ft.*lbf)
2.
INSTALL REAR WHEEL
(a) Install the rear wheel.
Torque: 103 N*m (1,050 kgf*cm, 76 ft.*lbf)
3.
STABILIZE SUSPENSION
(a) After lowering the vehicle, bounce the vehicle up
and down to stabilize the rear suspension.
4.
FULLY TIGHTEN REAR SHOCK ABSORBER WITH
COIL SPRING
(a) Tighten the rear shock absorber with coil spring
(lower side) installation nut.
Torque: 80 N*m (816 kgf*cm, 59 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Ensure the vehicle is lowered to the ground.
5.
INSTALL BATTERY CARRIER BRACKET (See page
HB-97)
6.
INSTALL DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY LH
(See page IR-15)
7.
INSTALL DECK FLOOR BOX LH
8.
INSTALL REAR NO. 4 FLOOR BOARD
9.
INSTALL REAR SIDE SEATBACK FRAME LH (See
page IR-17)
G027360E01
C067565E01
10. INSTALL REAR NO. 1 FLOOR BOARD (See page IR16)
11. INSTALL REAR SEATBACK ASSEMBLY LH (See
page SE-22)
12. INSTALL TONNEAU COVER ASSEMBLY
13. INSTALL REAR DECK TRIM COVER (See page IR-16)
14. INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX
SP
SP–36
SUSPENSION – REAR SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL SPRING
15. INSTALL REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD
16. INSPECT REAR WHEEL ALIGNMENT
(a) Inspect the rear wheel alignment (see page SP-10).
17. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform the initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
DISPOSAL
A
1.
B
F045732E01
SP
DISPOSE OF REAR SHOCK ABSORBER ASSEMBLY
LH
(a) Fully extend the shock absorber rod.
(b) Make a hole in the cylinder somewhere between A
and B shown in the illustration to discharge the gas
inside using a drill.
CAUTION:
Be careful when drilling because shards of
metal may fly about, so always use the proper
safety equipment.
NOTICE:
The gas is colorless, odorless and nonpoisonous.
SP–37
SUSPENSION – REAR AXLE BEAM
REAR AXLE BEAM
SUSPENSION & AXLE
COMPONENTS
REAR SHOCK ABSORBER
WITH COIL SPRING
5.0 (51, 44 in.*lbf)
SKID CONTROL
SENSOR WIRE
SPACER
80 (816, 59)
REAR AXLE HUB AND
BEARING ASSEMBLY LH
w/ HID Headlight System:
REAR HEIGHT CONTROL
SENSOR SUB-ASSEMBLY LH
REAR SENSOR
CONNECTING BRACKET
PARKING BRAKE
PLATE ASSEMBLY
REAR AXLE
BEAM DAMPER
61 (622, 45)
80 (816, 59)
REAR BRAKE
DRUM SUB-ASSEMBLY
SP
149 (1,520, 110)
REAR AXLE BEAM ASSEMBLY
REAR AXLE CARRIER BUSH LH
REAR STABILIZER BAR
FLOOR PANEL SIDE PLATE LH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
Non-reusable part
C129276E01
SP–38
SUSPENSION – REAR AXLE BEAM
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
2.
REMOVE FLOOR PANEL SIDE PLATE LH
(a) Remove the 3 bolts and floor panel side plate.
3.
REMOVE FLOOR PANEL SIDE PLATE RH
(a) Remove the 3 bolts and floor panel side plate.
4.
REMOVE REAR HEIGHT CONTROL SENSOR SUBASSEMBLY LH (w/ HID Headlight System)
(a) Remove the nut and height control sensor.
5.
REMOVE REAR SENSOR CONNECTING BRACKET
(w/ HID Headlight System)
(a) Remove the 2 nuts and sensor connecting bracket.
6.
REMOVE REAR BRAKE DRUM SUB-ASSEMBLY (See
page BR-47)
7.
DISCONNECT SKID CONTROL SENSOR WIRE
(a) Remove the 2 bolts and clip, and disconnect the
skid control sensor wire and parking brake cable
from the rear axle beam.
NOTICE:
• Ensure no foreign matter is on the end of the
skid control sensor wire.
• Ensure that the skid control sensor wire is
disconnected from the rear axle beam.
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH
side.
8.
REMOVE REAR AXLE BEAM DAMPER (See page SP44)
9.
REMOVE REAR STABILIZER BAR (See page SP-45)
G027352E01
G027356E01
G027357E01
SP
G027358E01
SUSPENSION – REAR AXLE BEAM
SP–39
10. DISCONNECT REAR NO. 4 BRAKE TUBE
(a) Using SST, disconnect the rear brake tube from the
flexible hose.
SST 09023-00101
NOTICE:
Do not damage the rear brake tube or flexible
hose.
(b) Remove the clip.
SST
C066801E01
11. DISCONNECT REAR NO. 3 BRAKE TUBE
HINT:
Use the same procedures as the rear No. 4 brake tube.
12. REMOVE REAR AXLE HUB AND BEARING
ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the 4 bolts. Remove the axle hub and
bearing and parking brake plate from the rear axle
beam.
NOTICE:
• Do not twist the parking brake cable.
• Use rope, etc. to suspend the parking brake
plate.
C066800E01
13. REMOVE REAR AXLE HUB AND BEARING
ASSEMBLY RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
14. DISCONNECT REAR SHOCK ABSORBER WITH COIL
SPRING
(a) Remove the 2 nuts from the left and right sides.
(b) Disconnect the rear shock absorber with coil springs
(lower side) from the rear axle beam.
C067565E01
15. REMOVE REAR AXLE BEAM ASSEMBLY
(a) Support the rear axle beam with a jack. Insert a
wooden block between the jack and the center of
the rear axle beam to prevent damage.
Wooden Block
C066806E01
SP
SP–40
SUSPENSION – REAR AXLE BEAM
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and 2 nuts from the left and right
sides.
NOTICE:
Keep the nut from rotating when removing the
bolt.
(c) Remove the rear axle beam by slowly lowering the
jack.
NOTICE:
Ensure that the skid control sensor wire is
completely disconnected from the rear axle
beam.
G028839E01
Matchmark
DISASSEMBLY
Hold
1.
REMOVE REAR AXLE CARRIER BUSH LH
(a) Place a matchmark on the rear axle beam after
aligning it with the bush recess.
(b) Make 2 bends in the rim of the bush using a chisel
and hammer.
(c) Using SST, remove the bush from the rear axle
beam.
SST 09950-40011 (09951-04020, 09952-04010,
09953-04030, 09954-04020, 09955-04051,
09957-04010, 09958-04011), 09950-60010
(09951-00630)
NOTICE:
• Do not erase the matchmark on the rear axle
beam when removing the bush.
• Apply chassis black if the rear axle beam is
scratched.
2.
REMOVE REAR AXLE CARRIER BUSH RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
Recess
Bend
Turn
SST
Recess
F047402E01
SP
SUSPENSION – REAR AXLE BEAM
SP–41
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL REAR AXLE CARRIER BUSH LH
(a) When replacing only the bush:
(1) Temporarily install a new bush recess by
aligning it with the matchmark on the rear axle
beam.
NOTICE:
Install the bush in the same direction as
before it was removed.
(b) When replacing the rear axle beam:
(1) Temporarily install a new bush as shown in the
illustration.
Vehicle Front
0.53’ +-3°
F047479E02
(c) Using SST, install the bush to the rear axle beam.
SST 09950-40011 (09951-04020, 09952-04010,
09953-04030, 09954-04020, 09955-04051,
09957-04010, 09958-04011), 09950-60010
(09951-00620), 09710-04101
NOTICE:
• Hang the claw of SST to the bush firmly.
• Do not damage the rubber sections indicated
by the arrow in the illustration when installing
the bush.
Hold
SST
Turn
2.
INSTALL REAR AXLE CARRIER BUSH RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
SP
F047404E01
INSTALLATION
1.
Wooden Block
C066806E01
TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN REAR AXLE BEAM
ASSEMBLY
(a) Support the rear axle beam with a jack. Insert a
wooden block between the jack and the center of
thee rear axle beam to prevent damage.
(b) Slowly raise the jack to install the rear axle beam on
the vehicle. Insert the 2 bolts from the inner side of
the vehicle and temporarily tighten them with the 2
nuts (1 nut and bolt each for the left and right sides).
SP–42
SUSPENSION – REAR AXLE BEAM
2.
TEMPORARILY TIGHTEN REAR SHOCK ABSORBER
WITH COIL SPRING
(a) Install the left and right side rear shock absorber
with coil spring (lower side) to the rear axle beam.
Temporarily tighten the nuts.
3.
INSTALL REAR AXLE HUB AND BEARING
ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Install the parking brake plate and the axle hub and
bearing to the rear axle beam with the 4 bolts.
Torque: 61 N*m (622 kgf*cm, 45 ft.*lbf)
4.
INSTALL REAR AXLE HUB AND BEARING
ASSEMBLY RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH side.
5.
CONNECT REAR NO. 4 BRAKE TUBE
(a) Temporarily tighten the rear brake tube and flexible
hose.
NOTICE:
• Do not damage the rear brake tube or flexible
hose.
• Replace the rear brake tube and flexible hose
with new parts if they are damaged.
(b) Install the rear brake tube to the rear axle beam and
secure it with the clip.
C067565E01
C066800E01
C066807E01
(c) Fully tighten the rear brake tube using SST.
SST 09023-00101
Torque: 15 N*m (155 kgf*cm, 11 ft.*lbf)
SST
SP
6.
CONNECT REAR NO. 3 BRAKE TUBE
HINT:
Use the same procedures as the rear No. 4 brake tube.
7.
INSTALL REAR STABILIZER BAR (See page SP-45)
8.
INSTALL REAR AXLE BEAM DAMPER (See page SP45)
9.
CONNECT SKID CONTROL SENSOR WIRE
(a) Install the skid control sensor wire and parking
brake cable to the rear axle beam using the 2 bolts
and clip.
Torque: 5.4 N*m (55 kgf*cm, 48 in.*lbf) for bolt A
5.0 N*m (51 kgf*cm, 44 in.*lbf) for bolt B
NOTICE:
Do not twist the skid control sensor wire while
installing it.
C066801E01
Bolt A
Bolt B
G027358E03
SUSPENSION – REAR AXLE BEAM
SP–43
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH
side.
10. INSTALL REAR BRAKE DRUM SUB-ASSEMBLY (See
page BR-53)
11. INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
(a) Install the rear wheel.
Torque: 103 N*m (1,050 kgf*cm, 76 ft.*lbf)
12. STABILIZE SUSPENSION
(a) After jacking down the vehicle, bounce the vehicle
up and down to stabilize the rear suspension.
13. FULLY TIGHTEN REAR AXLE BEAM ASSEMBLY
(a) Hold the nut and rotate the bolt to fully tighten the
rear axle beam on the LH side.
Torque: 85 N*m (867 kgf*cm, 63 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Ensure the vehicle is lowered to the ground.
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH
side.
G028839E01
C067565E01
14. FULLY TIGHTEN REAR SHOCK ABSORBER WITH
COIL SPRING
(a) Install the rear shock absorber with coil spring
(lower side) and tighten the nut.
Torque: 80 N*m (816 kgf*cm, 59 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Ensure the vehicle is lowered to the ground.
HINT:
Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH
side.
15. INSTALL REAR SENSOR CONNECTING BRACKET
(w/ HID Headlight System)
(a) Install the sensor connecting bracket with the 2
nuts.
SP
G027357E01
SP–44
SUSPENSION – REAR AXLE BEAM
16. INSTALL REAR HEIGHT CONTROL SENSOR SUBASSEMBLY LH (w/ HID Headlight System)
(a) Install the height control sensor with the nut.
G027356E01
17. INSTALL FLOOR PANEL SIDE PLATE LH
(a) Install the floor panel side plate with the 3 bolts.
18. INSTALL FLOOR PANEL SIDE PLATE RH
(a) Install the floor panel side plate with the 3 bolts.
19. BLEED BRAKE LINE
(a) Bleed brake line (see page BR-3).
20. INSPECT BRAKE FLUID
G027352E01
21. INSPECT REAR WHEEL ALIGNMENT
(a) Inspect the rear wheel alignment (see page SP-10).
22. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform the initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
23. ADJUST HEADLIGHT AIM ONLY (See page LI-80)
24. CHECK SPEED SENSOR SIGNAL
(a) Check the speed sensor signal (see page BC-37).
SP
SP–44
SUSPENSION – REAR STABILIZER BAR
REAR STABILIZER BAR
SUSPENSION & AXLE
COMPONENTS
REAR AXLE BEAM DAMPER
REAR STABILIZER BAR
149 (1,520, 110)
149 (1,520, 110)
REAR AXLE BEAM ASSEMBLY
SP
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C129275E01
SUSPENSION – REAR STABILIZER BAR
SP–45
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE REAR AXLE BEAM DAMPER
(a) Remove the rear axle beam damper from the rear
axle beam.
2.
REMOVE REAR STABILIZER BAR
(a) Remove the 2 bolts, 2 nuts and stabilizer bar.
G027354E01
INSTALLATION
Vehicle Front
1.
INSTALL REAR STABILIZER BAR
(a) Install the stabilizer bar so that the mark position
faces towards the vehicle's rear right. Hold the bolts
and tighten the nuts.
Torque: 149 N*m (1,520 kgf*cm, 110 ft.*lbf)
2.
INSTALL REAR AXLE BEAM DAMPER
(a) Install the rear axle beam damper to the center of
the rear axle beam.
Mark Position
G027359E01
G027355E01
SP
STEERING COLUMN – STEERING SYSTEM
SR–1
STEERING SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
1.
2.
HANDLING PRECAUTIONS FOR SRS AIRBAG
SYSTEM (SEE PAGE RS-1)
HANDLING PRECAUTIONS FOR STEERING
COLUMN
(a) When handling the steering column assembly:
(1) Avoid any impact to the steering column
assembly, especially to the motor or the torque
sensor. Replace with a new one if dropped or
subjected to the severe impact.
(2) Do not pull on the wire harness when moving the
steering column assembly.
(3) When the steering column assembly or other
steering-related parts have been removed and
either reinstalled or replaced, perform the
steering center point adjustment (zero point
calibration) (see page IN-32).
(b) When disconnecting and reconnecting the
connectors:
(1) When disconnecting the connector related to the
electronic motor power steering system, turn the
power switch ON (IG), center the steering wheel,
turn the power switch off, and then disconnect
the connector.
(2) When reconnecting the connector related to the
electronic motor power steering system, turn the
power switch OFF, Center the steering wheel,
and then turn the power switch ON (IG) before
reconnecting the connector.
NOTICE:
Do not turn the power switch ON (IG) when
the steering wheel is not centered.
(3) If the procedures above are not perform
properly, the steering center point (zero point)
will deviate, which will lead to a difference in
steering effort between right and left. If there is a
difference in the steering effort between right
and left, perform the steering center point
adjustment (zero point calibration) (see page IN32).
NOTICE:
FOR INITIALIZATION
When disconnecting the cable from the
negative (-) battery terminal, initialize the
following systems after the cable is
reconnected.
System Name
See Page
Power Window Control System
IN-32
NOTICE:
FOR HYBRID SYSTEM ACTIVATION
SR
SR–2
STEERING COLUMN – STEERING SYSTEM
• When the warning light is illuminated or
the battery has been disconnected and
reconnected, press the power switch may
not start the system on the first try. If so,
press the power switch again.
• With the power switch's power mode
changed to ON (IG), disconnect the
battery. If the key is not in the slot during
reconnection, DTC B2799 may be output.
SR
SR–3
STEERING COLUMN – STEERING SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
Use the table below to help determine the cause of the
problem symptom. The potential causes of the symptoms are
listed in order of probability in the "Suspected area" column of
the table. Check each symptom by checking the suspected
areas in the order they are listed. Replace parts as
necessary.
Steering system
Symptom
Suspected area
Hard steering
Poor return
No free play or excessive play
Knocking (or clanking) sound occurs when turning
steering wheel back and forth while power steering is
in operation.
Friction sound occurs when turning steering wheel
during low speed driving.
High-pitched sound (squealing sound) occurs when
turning steering wheel slowly with vehicle stopped.
Steering wheel vibrates and noise occurs when turning
steering wheel from lock to lock.
See page
1. Front tires (improperly inflated, unevenly worn)
TW-3
2. Front wheel alignment (Incorrect)
SP-2
3. Front suspension (Lower ball joint)
SP-24
4. Steering intermediate shaft
SR-11
5. Steering column
SR-5
6. Steering gear
PS-48
7. Power steering ECU
SR-16
1. Front tires (improperly inflated, unevenly worn)
TW-3
2. Front wheels alignment (Incorrect)
SP-2
3. Steering column
SR-5
4. Steering gear
PS-48
5. Power steering ECU
SR-16
1. Steering intermediate shaft
SR-11
2. Steering gear
PS-48
1. Steering intermediate shaft
SR-11
2. Front suspension (Lower ball joint)
SP-24
3. Front axle hub (Hub bearing)
AH-4
4. Steering gear
PS-48
1. Power steering motor
SR-7
2. Steering column
SR-5
1. Power steering motor
SR-7
1. Power steering motor
SR-7
2. Steering column
SR-5
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
Maximum
Free Play
30 mm
F046393E03
1.
CHECK STEERING WHEEL FREE PLAY
(a) Stop the vehicle and align the tires straight ahead.
(b) Turn the steering wheel gently right and left, and
check the steering wheel free play.
Maximum free play:
30 mm (1.18 in.)
If the free play exceeds the maximum, replace the
steering intermediate shaft sub-assembly or
steering gear.
SR
SR–4
STEERING COLUMN – STEERING SYSTEM
REPAIR
Steering Wheel
1.
Masking Tape
Steering Column
Upper Cover
STEERING POSITION
(a) Apply masking tape on the top center of the steering
wheel and steering column upper cover.
(b) Drive the vehicle in a straight line for 100 m (328 ft.)
at a constant speed of 56 km/h (35 mph), and hold
the steering wheel to maintain the course.
F016015E07
(c) Draw a line on the masking tape as shown in the
illustration.
Steering Column
Upper Cover
Marked Line
Steering Wheel
Masking
Tape
F016016E04
Steering Column
Upper Cover
Marked Line
Steering Wheel
SR
F016017E02
(d) Rotate the steering wheel to the center position.
HINT:
Locate the center position by looking at: 1) the
upper surface of the steering wheel, 2) the upper
cover, and 3) the horizontal line of the "SRS Airbag"
symbol imprinted on the steering pad.
(e) Draw a new line on the masking tape on the
steering wheel as shown in the illustration.
(f) Measure the distance between the 2 lines on the
masking tape on the steering wheel.
(g) Calculate the measured distance in terms of
steering angle.
Reference:
1 mm (0.004 in.) = 1°
HINT:
Make a note of the steering angle.
STEERING COLUMN – STEERING SYSTEM
2.
Marked Line
SR–5
ADJUST STEERING ANGLE
(a) Draw a line on the RH and LH tie rod ends and rack
ends, respectively, where it can be easily seen.
(b) Using a paper gauge, measure the distance from
the RH and LH tie rod ends to the rack end screws.
HINT:
• Measure both the RH and LH sides.
• Make a note of the measured values.
R000429E04
F051053E01
(c) Remove the RH and LH boot clips from the rack
boots.
(d) Loosen the RH and LH lock nuts.
(e) Turn the RH and LH rack ends equally in different
directions according to the steering angle.
Reference:
One 360° turn of rack end (1.5 mm (0.059 in.)
horizontal movement) is equal to 13° of
steering angle.
(f) Tighten the RH and LH lock nuts.
Torque: 74 N*m (750 kgf*cm, 54 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Make sure that the difference in length between
the RH and LH tie rod ends and rack end screws
is within 1.5 mm (0.059 in.).
(g) Install the RH and LH boot clips.
(h) Perform the steering angle sensor zero point
calibration (see page IN-32).
SR
SR–5
STEERING COLUMN – STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
STEERING COLUMN
COMPONENTS
w/ Cruise Control
STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY
STEERING WHEEL ASSEMBLY
NO. 2 STEERING WHEEL
COVER LOWER
8.8 (90, 78 in.*lbf)
50 (510, 37)
NO. 2 STEERING WHEEL
COVER LOWER
STEERING COLUMN UPPER COVER
8.8 (90, 78 in.*lbf)
NO. 3 STEERING WHEEL
COVER LOWER
STEERING COLUMN LOWER COVER
SR
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
G100842E01
SR–6
STEERING COLUMN – STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
TURN SIGNAL SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(WITH SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSEMBLY)
STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
CLAMP
25 (255, 18)
25 (255, 18)
NO. 2 STEERING INTERMEDIATE
SHAFT SUB-ASSEMBLY
35 (360, 26)
COLUMN HOLE COVER SILENCER SHEET
STEERING SLIDING YOKE
SUB-ASSEMBLY
35 (360, 26)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
SR
G100843E01
STEERING COLUMN – STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
SR–7
WIRE HARNESS CLAMP
18 (185, 13)
STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
POWER STEERING
MOTOR ASSEMBLY
TILT LEVER BRACKET
2.0 (20, 18 in.*lbf)
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
MP grease
G100844E01
SR
SR–8
STEERING COLUMN – STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
REMOVAL
Matchmark
1.
REMOVE NO. 2 REAR FLOOR BOARD
2.
REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX
3.
REMOVE NO. 3 REAR FLOOR BOARD ASSEMBLY
4.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
5.
PLACE FRONT WHEELS FACING STRAIGHT AHEAD
6.
REMOVE NO. 2 STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER
7.
REMOVE NO. 3 STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER
8.
REMOVE STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY (See page RS268)
9.
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the nut and put matchmarks on the
steering wheel and steering main shaft.
(b) Using SST, remove the steering wheel.
SST 09950-50013 (09951-05010, 09952-05010,
09953-05020, 09954-05021)
SST
G028394E02
10. REMOVE TILT LEVER BRACKET
(a) Remove the 2 screws and tilt lever bracket.
F046710E01
11. REMOVE STEERING COLUMN COVER
(a) Detach the 4 claws and remove the 3 screws. Then
remove the steering column lower cover and the
steering column upper cover.
12. REMOVE TURN SIGNAL SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the clamp and remove the turn signal
switch from the steering column.
SR
F046711E01
13. REMOVE SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page
RS-278)
14. REMOVE FRONT DOOR INSIDE SCUFF PLATE LH
(See page IR-7)
STEERING COLUMN – STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
SR–9
15. REMOVE FRONT DOOR INSIDE SCUFF PLATE RH
(See page IR-7)
16. REMOVE COWL SIDE TRIM BOARD LH (See page IR7)
17. REMOVE COWL SIDE TRIM BOARD RH (See page
IR-7)
18. REMOVE NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-5)
19. REMOVE LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page IP-6)
20. REMOVE UPPER INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page IP-6)
21. REMOVE NO. 3 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-6)
22. REMOVE NO. 4 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-6)
23. REMOVE NO. 2 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-7)
24. REMOVE MULTI-DISPLAY (See page NS-172)
25. REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR STOPPER
SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page IP-7)
26. REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-7)
27. REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR (See page
IP-7)
28. REMOVE NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL SPEAKER
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY (w/ JBL Sound System)
29. REMOVE FRONT PILLAR GARNISH CORNER PIECE
RH (See page IR-7)
30. REMOVE FRONT PILLAR GARNISH CORNER PIECE
LH (See page IR-7)
31. REMOVE FRONT PILLAR GARNISH ASSEMBLY LH
(See page IR-8)
32. REMOVE FRONT PILLAR GARNISH ASSEMBLY RH
(See page IR-8)
33. DISCONNECT PASSENGER AIRBAG CONNECTOR
(See page RS-282)
34. REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL PASSENGER
AIRBAG ASSEMBLY (See page RS-282)
SR
SR–10
STEERING COLUMN – STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
35. DISCONNECT POWER STEERING ECU ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the torque sensor wire harness clamp
from the bottom surface of the power steering ECU.
(b) Disconnect the torque sensor wire harness clamp
from the instrument panel reinforcement.
(c) Disconnect the 2 steering column connectors from
the power steering ECU.
36. REMOVE FRONT FLOOR FOOTREST LH
(a) Using a flat head screwdriver, pull the front floor
footrest forward, detach the 2 clips, and remove the
front floor footrest.
G028396E01
37. REMOVE COLUMN HOLE COVER SILENCER SHEET
(a) Fold back the floor carpet and remove the 2 clips
and column hole cover silencer sheet.
G028397E01
Matchmark
Bolt C
Matchmark
Bolt A
Bolt B
G028398E05
38. REMOVE NO. 2 STEERING INTERMEDIATE SHAFT
SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Loosen the bolt labeled A on the steering sliding
yoke.
(b) Put matchmarks on the steering intermediate shaft
and steering intermediate shaft.
(c) Remove the bolt labeled B and separate the
steering intermediate shaft from the steering
intermediate shaft.
(d) Put matchmarks on the steering intermediate shaft
and steering column.
(e) Remove the bolt labeled C and separate the
steering intermediate shaft from the steering
column.
39. REMOVE STEERING SLIDING YOKE SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the bolt and steering sliding yoke from the
steering intermediate shaft.
SR
G029330E01
STEERING COLUMN – STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
SR–11
40. REMOVE STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connectors and wire harness clamps
from the steering column.
(b) Remove the 3 bolts and steering column.
F046713E01
DISASSEMBLY
1.
REMOVE POWER STEERING MOTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the 2 clamps from the power steering
motor and torque sensor wire harness.
NOTICE:
Do not damage the clamps.
(b) Remove the 2 bolts and power steering motor.
G028401E01
INSPECTION
1.
G028400E01
INSPECT STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
(a) Using SST and a torque wrench, measure the main
shaft turning torque.
SST 09616-00011
Standard turning torque:
0.4 to 1.1 N*m (4 to 11 kgf*cm, 4 to 10 in.*lb) (2
sec./turn)
(b) If turning torque is out of the specification, remove
the motor and remeasure.
Reference turning torque:
0.1 to 0.6 N*m (1 to 6 kgf*cm, 1 to 5 in.*lb) (2
sec./turn) (motorless)
If turning torque is within the specification, replace
the motor within a new one.
If turning torque is out of the specification, replace
the steering column assembly with a new one.
SR
SR–12
STEERING COLUMN – STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
REASSEMBLY
1.
INSTALL POWER STEERING MOTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Secure the steering column in a vise so that the
motor installation part is horizontal.
(b) Apply MP grease to the serrated part of the motor
and install it to the steering column.
Reference amount:
0.3 g (0.0106 oz.)
(c) Using SST, turn the steering main shaft 2 or 3 turns
at a rate of one turn per second to seat the motor,
and temporarily tighten the 2 bolts.
NOTICE:
• Make sure that the motor is installed
vertically and sits under its own weight.
• Temporarily tighten the bolts with the motor
properly seated.
(d) Fully tighten the 2 bolts.
Torque: 18 N*m (185 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
Do not apply force to the motor in the horizontal
direction when tighten the bolts.
SST
G029327E02
(e) Hold the wire harness for the power steering motor
and torque sensor wire harness with the 2 clamps
and vinyl tape as shown in the illustration.
270 to 290 mm
(10.63 to 11.42 in.)
130 to 150 mm
(5.12 to 5.91 in.)
140 to 160 mm
(5.51 to 6.30 in.)
Clamp
280 to 300 mm
(11.02 to 11.81 in.)
G029329E02
INSTALLATION
1.
SR
F046713E01
INSTALL STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the steering column with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 25 N*m (255 kgf*cm, 18 ft.*lbf)
(b) Connect the connectors and wire harness clamps to
the steering column.
STEERING COLUMN – STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
SR–13
2.
INSTALL STEERING SLIDING YOKE SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Temporarily install the steering sliding yoke subassembly to the steering intermediate shaft with the
bolt.
3.
INSTALL STEERING INTERMEDIATE SHAFT SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Align the matchmarks on the steering intermediate
shaft assembly and steering column and install
them with the bolt labeled C.
Torque: 35 N*m (360 kgf*cm, 26 ft.*lbf)
(b) Align the matchmark on the steering intermediate
shaft and steering intermediate shaft and install
them with the bolt labeled B.
Torque: 35 N*m (360 kgf*cm, 26 ft.*lbf)
(c) Tighten the bolt labeled A on the steering sliding
yoke.
Torque: 35 N*m (360 kgf*cm, 26 ft.*lbf)
4.
INSTALL COLUMN HOLE COVER SILENCER SHEET
5.
INSTALL FRONT FLOOR FOOTREST LH
(a) Attach the 2 clips to install the front floor footrest.
6.
INSTALL POWER STEERING ECU ASSEMBLY
(a) Connect the 2 steering column connectors to the
power steering ECU.
(b) Install the clamp holding the power steering motor
and torque sensor wire harness on the bottom
surface of the power steering computer.
(c) Install the torque sensor wire harness clamp to the
instrument panel reinforcement.
(d) Make sure that the power steering motor and torque
sensor wire harnesses do not interfere with other
parts while tilting up and down the steering column.
7.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL PASSENGER
AIRBAG ASSEMBLY (See page RS-282)
8.
DISCONNECT PASSENGER AIRBAG CONNECTOR
(See page RS-283)
9.
INSTALL FRONT PILLAR GARNISH ASSEMBLY LH
(See page IR-18)
G029330E01
Matchmark
Bolt C
Matchmark
Bolt A
Bolt B
G028398E05
G028396E01
10. INSTALL FRONT PILLAR GARNISH ASSEMBLY RH
(See page IR-17)
11. INSTALL FRONT PILLAR GARNISH CORNER PIECE
LH (See page IR-19)
12. INSTALL FRONT PILLAR GARNISH CORNER PIECE
RH (See page IR-19)
SR
SR–14
STEERING COLUMN – STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
13. INSTALL NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL SPEAKER
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY (w/ JBL Sound System)
14. INSTALL GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR (See page
IP-12)
15. INSTALL GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR ASSEMBLY
(See page IP-12)
16. INSTALL GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR STOPPER
SUB-ASSEMBLY
17. INSTALL MULTI-DISPLAY (See page NS-172)
18. INSTALL NO. 2 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-12)
19. INSTALL NO. 4 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-12)
20. INSTALL NO. 3 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-13)
21. INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL SUBASSEMBLY (See page IP-13)
22. INSTALL NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-13)
23. INSTALL COWL SIDE TRIM BOARD RH (See page IR19)
24. INSTALL COWL SIDE TRIM BOARD LH (See page IR19)
25. INSTALL FRONT DOOR INSIDE SCUFF PLATE LH
(See page IR-18)
26. INSTALL FRONT DOOR INSIDE SCUFF PLATE RH
(See page IR-18)
27. INSTALL SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page
RS-278)
28. INSPECT SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page
RS-278)
29. INSTALL TURN SIGNAL SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the turn signal switch to the steering column
with the clamp.
SR
30. INSTALL STEERING COLUMN COVER
(a) Engage the 4 claws to install the steering column
upper cover and steering column lower cover.
HINT:
Fully tilt down the steering column when installing
the steering column upper cover and fully tilt it up
when installing the steering column cover.
31. INSTALL TILT LEVER BRACKET
(a) Install the tilt level bracket with the 2 screws.
Torque: 2.0 N*m (20 kgf*cm, 18 in.*lbf)
STEERING COLUMN – STEERING COLUMN ASSEMBLY
SR–15
32. INSPECT STEERING WHEEL CENTER POINT
HINT:
When the steering wheel is not properly centered,
remove and refit to center.
33. INSTALL STEERING WHEEL ASSEMBLY
(a) Align the matchmarks on the steering wheel and
steering main shaft.
(b) Install the steering wheel with the set nut.
Torque: 50 N*m (510 kgf*cm, 37 ft.*lbf)
34. INSTALL STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY (See page RS269)
35. CONNECT CABLE TO BATTERY NEGATIVE
TERMINAL
36. INSPECT STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY
(a) Inspect the steering pad (see page RS-267).
37. INSTALL NO. 3 STEERING WHEEL LOWER COVER
38. INSTALL NO. 2 STEERING WHEEL LOWER COVER
39. INSTALL REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD ASSEMBLY
40. INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX
41. INSTALL REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD
42. INSPECT SRS WARNING LIGHT
(a) Inspect SRS warning light (see page RS-31).
43. PERFORM CALIBRATION
(a) Perform calibration (see page PS-13).
44. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
SR
SR–16
STEERING COLUMN – STEERING CONTROL ECU
STEERING CONTROL ECU
REMOVAL
1.
PRECAUTION
Precaution (see page SR-1)
2.
REMOVE NO. 2 REAR FLOOR BOARD
3.
REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX
4.
REMOVE NO. 3 REAR FLOOR BOARD ASSEMBLY
5.
DISCONNECT BATTERY NEGATIVE TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
6.
REMOVE NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-5)
7.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH LOWER
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page IP-6)
8.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH UPPER
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page IP-6)
9.
REMOVE NO. 3 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-6)
10. REMOVE NO. 4 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-6)
11. REMOVE NO. 2 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-7)
12. REMOVE MULTI-DISPLAY ASSEMBLY (See page NS172)
13. REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR STOPPER
SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page IP-7)
14. REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-7)
15. REMOVE GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR (See page
IP-7)
16. REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL NO. 1 SPEAKER
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY (JBL Sound System)
17. REMOVE FRONT PILLAR GARNISH CORNER PIECE
LH (See page IR-19)
18. REMOVE FRONT PILLAR GARNISH CORNER PIECE
RH (See page IR-19)
SR
19. REMOVE FRONT PILLAR GARNISH LH (See page IR8)
20. REMOVE FRONT PILLAR GARNISH RH (See page IR8)
STEERING COLUMN – STEERING CONTROL ECU
SR–17
21. REMOVE PASSENGER AIRBAG CONNECTOR (See
page RS-282)
22. REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-8)
23. REMOVE POWER STEERING ECU
(a) Separate the torque sensor wire harness clamp
from the ECU.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the torque sensor wire
harness clamp.
(b) Disconnect the 4 ECU connectors.
G028402E01
(c) Remove the 3 screws and ECU.
G028403E01
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL POWER STEERING ECU
(a) Install the ECU with the 3 screws.
Torque: 5.0 N*m (50 kgf*cm, 44 in.*lbf)
G028403E01
(b) Connect the 4 ECU connectors.
(c) Install the torque sensor wire harness clamp to the
ECU.
2.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL SAFETY PAD (See
page IP-11)
3.
INSTALL PASSENGER AIRBAG CONNECTOR (See
page RS-283)
4.
INSTALL FRONT PILLAR GARNISH LH (See page IR18)
5.
INSTALL FRONT PILLAR GARNISH RH (See page IR18)
6.
INSTALL FRONT PILLAR GARNISH CORNER PIECE
LH (See page IR-19)
G028402E01
SR
SR–18
STEERING COLUMN – STEERING CONTROL ECU
7.
INSTALL FRONT PILLAR GARNISH CORNER PIECE
RH (See page IR-19)
8.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL NO. 1 SPEAKER
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY (w/ JBL Sound System)
9.
INSTALL GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR (See page
IP-12)
10. INSTALL GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR ASSEMBLY
(See page IP-12)
11. INSTALL GLOVE COMPARTMENT DOOR STOPPER
SUB-ASSEMBLY
12. INSTALL MULTI-DISPLAY ASSEMBLY (See page NS172)
13. INSTALL NO. 2 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-12)
14. INSTALL NO. 4 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-12)
15. INSTALL NO. 3 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-13)
16. INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL
UPPER SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page IP-13)
17. INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL
LOWER SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page IP-13)
18. INSTALL NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-13)
19. CONNECT CABLE TO BATTERY NEGATIVE
TERMINAL
20. INSTALL NO. 3 REAR FLOOR BOARD
21. INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX
22. INSTALL NO. 2 REAR FLOOR BOARD
23. INSPECT SRS WARNING LIGHT
(a) Inspect the SRS warning light (see page RS-31).
24. PERFORM CALIBRATION
(a) Perform calibration (see page PS-13).
25. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
SR
SS–1
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – STANDARD BOLT
STANDARD BOLT
HOW TO DETERMINE BOLT
STRENGTH
Bolt Type
Hexagon Head Bolt
Stud Bolt
Normal Recess Bolt
Weld Bolt
Class
Deep Recess Bolt
No Mark
No Mark
No Mark
4T
5T
w/ Washer
w/ Washer
6T
7T
8T
9T
10T
11T
SS
SS–2
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – STANDARD BOLT
SPECIFIED TORQUE FOR STANDARD
BOLTS
Class
4T
SS
5T
6T
7T
8T
9T
10T
11T
Diameter
(mm)
Pitch
(mm)
Specified torque
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
6
1
5
55
48 in.*lbf
6
60
52 in.*lbf
8
1.25
12.5
130
9
14
145
10
10
1.25
26
260
19
29
290
21
12
1.25
47
480
35
53
540
39
14
1.5
74
760
55
84
850
61
Hexagon head bolt
Hexagon flange bolt
16
1.5
115
1,150
83
-
-
-
6
1
6.5
65
56 in.*lbf
7.5
75
65 in.*lbf
8
1.25
15.5
160
12
17.5
175
13
10
1.25
32
330
24
36
360
26
12
1.25
59
600
43
65
670
48
14
1.5
91
930
67
100
1,050
76
16
1.5
140
1,400
101
-
-
-
6
1
8
80
69 in.*lbf
9
90
78 in.*lbf
8
1.25
19
195
14
21
210
15
10
1.25
39
400
29
44
440
32
12
1.25
71
730
53
80
810
59
14
1.5
110
1,100
80
125
1,250
90
16
1.5
170
1,750
127
-
-
-
6
1
10.5
110
8
12
120
9
8
1.25
25
260
19
28
290
21
10
1.25
52
530
38
58
590
43
12
1.25
95
970
70
105
1,050
76
14
1.5
145
1,500
108
165
1,700
123
16
1.5
230
2,300
166
-
-
-
8
1.25
29
300
22
33
330
24
10
1.25
61
620
45
68
690
50
12
1.25
110
1,100
80
120
1,250
90
8
1.25
34
340
25
37
380
27
10
1.25
70
710
51
78
790
57
12
1.25
125
1,300
94
140
1,450
105
8
1.25
38
390
28
42
430
31
10
1.25
78
800
58
88
890
64
12
1.25
140
1,450
105
155
1,600
116
8
1.25
42
430
31
47
480
35
10
1.25
87
890
64
97
990
72
12
1.25
155
1,600
116
175
1,800
130
SS–3
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – STANDARD BOLT
HOW TO DETERMINE NUT STRENGTH
Nut Type
Present Standard Hexagon Nut
Old Standard Hexagon Nut
Cold Forging Nut
Class
Cutting Processed Nut
No Mark
No Mark (w/ Washer)
4N
No Mark (w/ Washer)
No Mark
5N (4T)
6N
7N (5T)
8N
No Mark
10N (7T)
11N
12N
HINT:
• *: Nut with 1 or more marks on one side surface of the nut.
• Use the nut with the same number of the nut strength
classification or greater than the bolt strength classification
number when tightening parts with a bolt and nut.
Example:
• Bolt = 4T
• Nut = 4N or more
SS
SS–4
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL
SYSTEM
SERVICE DATA
SS
Camshaft timing oil control valve
- Standard resistance
Terminals 1 - 2
at 20°C (68°F)
-
6.9 to 7.9 Ω
Camshaft position sensor
- Standard resistance
Terminals 1 - 2
Cold
The terms "Cold" and "Hot" refer
to the temperature of the sensor.
"Cold" means approximately -10
to 50°C (14 to 122°F). "Hot"
means approximately 50 to
100°C (122 to 212°F).
1,630 to 2,740 Ω
The terms "Cold" and "Hot" refer
to the temperature of the sensor.
"Cold" means approximately -10
to 50°C (14 to 122°F). "Hot"
means approximately 50 to
100°C (122 to 212°F).
985 to 1,600 Ω
Terminals 1 - 2
Hot
Crankshaft position sensor
- Standard resistance
Terminals 1 - 2
Cold
Terminals 1 - 2
Hot
2,065 to 3,225 Ω
1,265 to 1,890 Ω
Engine coolant temperature
sensor
- Standard resistance
Terminals 1 - 2
at 20°C (68°F)
-
2.32 to 2.59 Ω
Terminals 1 - 2
at 80°C (176°F)
-
0.310 to 0.326 Ω
Throttle body (throttle control
motor)
- Standard resistance
Terminals 1 - 2
at 25 °C (77°F)
-
50 MΩ or more
Throttle body (throttle position
sensor)
- Standard resistance
Terminals 1 - 4
at 25 °C (77°F)
-
1.2 to 3.5 kΩ
Knock sensor
- Standard resistance
Terminals 1 - 2
at 20°C (68°F)
-
120 to 280 kΩ
EFI relay
- Standard resistance
Terminals 3I-5 - 3I-8
-
10 kΩor higher
Terminals 3I-5 - 3I-8
When battery voltage is applied to
terminals 3I-6 and 3I-7)
Below 1 Ω
Terminals 3G-5 - 3G-8
-
10 kΩ or higher
Terminals 3G-5 - 3G-8
When battery voltage is applied to
terminals 3G-6 and 3G-7)
Below 1 Ω
Circuit opening relay
- Standard resistance
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1NZ-FXE ENGINE CONTROL SYSTEM
SS–5
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Camshaft timing oil control valve
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Camshaft timing oil control
valve x Cylinder head
7.5
76
66 in.*lbf
Camshaft position sensor
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Camshaft position sensor x
Cylinder head
7.5
76
66 in.*lbf
Crankshaft position sensor
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Crankshaft position sensor x
Cylinder block
7.5
76
66 in.*lbf
Engine coolant temperature sensor
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Engine coolant temperature
sensor x Cylinder head
20
204
15
Throttle body
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Throttle with motor body x
Intake manifold
20
204
15
Air cleaner x Cylinder head
cover
7.0
71
62 in.*lbf
Air cleaner x Throttle with
motor
3.0
31
27 in.*lbf
No. 1 air cleaner inlet x Air
cleaner
3.0
31
27 in.*lbf
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
knock sensor x Cylinder block
20
204
15
Intake manifold x Cylinder head
20
204
15
Harness clamp x Intake
manifold
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
Oil dipstick guide x Intake
manifold
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
Knock sensor
ECM
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
ECM x Hybrid vehicle control
ECU
3.0
31
80 in.*lbf
ECM x Body
3.0
31
80 in.*lbf
SS
SS–6
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL
1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL
SERVICE DATA
Drive belt
SS
New drive belt deflection
: Pressing force: 98 N (10 kgf, 22lbf)
9.0 to 12.0 mm (0.35 to 0.47 in.)
Used drive belt deflection
: Pressing force: 98 N (10 kgf, 22lbf)
11.0 to 15.0 mm (0.43 to 0.59 in.)
New drive belt tension
392 to 588 N (40 to 60 kgf, 88 to 132 lb)
Used drive belt tension
196 to 392 N (20 to 40 kgf, 44 to 88 lb)
Ignition timing
8 to 12° BTDC
Idle speed
950 to 1050 rpm
Compression
Valve clearance (cold)
Standard pressure
882 kPa (9.0 kgf/cm2 128 psi)
Minimum pressure
686 kPa (7.0 kgf/cm2 99 psi)
Difference between each cylinder
Within 98 kPa (1.0kgf/cm2 14 psi)
Intake
0.17 to 0.23 mm (0.007 to 0.009 in.)
Exhaust
0.27 to 0.33 mm (0.011 to 0.013 in.)
Chain
Maximum elongation chain length at 16 links
124.2 mm (4.890 in.)
Camshaft timing gear
Minimum diameter (w / chain)
96.2 mm (3.787 in.)
Camshaft timing sprocket
Minimum diameter (w / chain)
96.2 mm (3.787 in.)
Chain tensioner slipper
Maximum wear
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
Chain vibration damper
Maximum wear
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
Cylinder head bolt
Standard length
142.8 to 144.2 mm (5.622 to 5.677 in.)
Maximum length
147.1 mm (5.791 in.)
Maximum Cylinder block side warpage
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
Cylinder head
Intake valve
Exhaust valve
Valve spring
Intake manifold side warpage
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
Exhaust manifold side warpage
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
Camshaft bearing cap setting ring pin
protrusion height
8.5 to 9.5 mm (0.335 to 0.374 in.)
Standard overall length
89.25 mm (3.5138 in.)
Minimum overall length
88.95 mm (3.5020 in.)
Standard valve stem diameter
4.970 to 4.985 mm (0.1957 to 0.1963 in.)
Standard valve margin thickness
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
Minimum valve margin thickness
0.7 mm (0.028 in.)
Standard overall length
87.90 mm (3.4606 in.)
Minimum overall length
87.60 mm (3.4488 in.)
Standard valve stem diameter
4.965 to 4.980 mm (0.1955 to 0.1961 in.)
Standard valve margin thickness
1.15 mm (0.0453 in.)
Minimum valve margin thickness
0.85 mm (0.0335 in.)
Standard free length
59.77 mm (2.3531 in.)
Maximum spring deviation
1.6 mm (0.063 in.)
Maximum spring angle (reference)
2°
Standard spring installed tension at 32.5 mm
(1.280 in.)
140 to 154 N (14.2 to 15.7 kgf, 31.5 to 34.6
lbf)
Maximum spring working tension at 25.1 mm
(0.988 in.)
180 to 198 N (18.4 to 20.2 kgf, 40.5 to 44.5
lbf)
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL
Valve guide bushing
Valve lifter
Camshaft
No. 2 camshaft
Cylinder block
Connecting rod
SS–7
Standard inside diameter
5.010 to 5.030 mm (0.1972 to 0.1980 in.)
Intake:
Standard oil clearance
0.025 to 0.060 mm ( 0.0010 to 0.0024 in.)
Intake:
Maximum oil clearance
0.08 mm (0.0031 in.)
Exhaust:
Standard oil clearance
0.030 to 0.065 mm (0.0012 to 0.0026 in.)
Exhaust:
Maximum oil clearance
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
Standard:
Standard guide bush diameter
9.685 to 9.706 mm (0.3813 to 0.3821 in.)
O/S:
Standard guide bush diameter
9.735 to 9.755 mm (0.3833 to 0.3841 in.)
Protrusion height
9.0 to 9.4 mm (0.354 to 0.370 in.)
Lifter diameter
30.966 to 30.976 mm (1.2191 to 1.2195 in.)
Lifter bore diameter
31.009 to 31.025 mm (1.2208 to 1.2215 in.)
Standard oil clearance
0.033 to 0.059 mm (0.0013 to 0.0023 in.)
Maximum oil clearance
0.10 mm (0.0039 in.)
Maximum circle runout
0.03 mm (0.0012 in.)
Standard cam lobe height
42.310 to 42.410 mm (1.6657 to 1.6697 in.)
Minimum cam lobe height
42.16 mm (1.6598 in.)
No. 1 journal diameter
34.449 to 34.465 mm (1.3563 to 1.3569 in.)
Other journals diameter
22.949 to 22.965 mm (0.9035 to 0.9041 in.)
Standard thrust clearance
0.040 to 0.095 mm (0.0016 to 0.0037 in.)
Maximum thrust clearance
0.11 mm (0.0043 in.)
Standard oil clearance
0.040 to 0.095 mm (0.0016 to 0.0037 in.)
Maximum oil clearance
0.115 mm (0.0045 in.)
Maximum circle runout
0.03 mm (0.0012 in.)
Standard cam lobe height
44.046 to 44.146 mm (1.7341 to 1.7380 in.)
Minimum cam lobe height
43.90 mm (1.7283 in.)
No. 1 journal diameter
34.449 to 34.465 mm (1.3563 to 1.3569 in.)
Other journals diameter
22.949 to 22.965 mm (0.9035 to 0.9041 in.)
Standard thrust clearance
0.040 to 0.095 mm (0.0016 to 0.0037 in.)
Maximum thrust clearance
0.11 mm (0.0043 in.)
Standard oil clearance
0.040 to 0.095 mm (0.0016 to 0.0037 in.)
Maximum oil clearance
0.115 mm (0.0045 in.)
Maximum warpage
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
Standard bore diameter
75.000 to 75.133 mm (2.9528 to 2.9580 in.)
End plate straight pin protrusion
11.5 to 12.5 mm (0.453 to 0.492 in.)
Oil pan straight pin protrusion
8.5 to 9.5 mm (0.335 to 0.374 in.)
Cylinder head set straight pin protrusion
8.5 to 9.5 mm (0.335 to 0.374 in.)
Chain tensioner straight pin protrusion
18.5 to 19.5 mm (0.728 to 0.768 in.)
Oil pump set ring pin protrusion
3.5 to 4.5 mm (0.138 to 0.177 in.)
Standard thrust clearance
0.16 to 0.36 mm (0.0063 to 0.0142 in.)
Maximum thrust clearance
0.36 mm (0.0142 in.)
Standard oil clearance
0.016 to 0.040 mm (0.0006 to 0.0016 in.)
Maximum oil clearance
0.06 mm (0.0024 in.)
Maximum out-of alignment
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.) per 100 mm (3.94 in.)
Maximum twist
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.) per 100 mm (3.94 in.)
Inside diameter
17.965 to 17.985 mm (0.7073 to 0.7081 in.)
SS
SS–8
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL
Piston
Piston ring
SS
Connecting rod bolt
Crankshaft
Crankshaft bearing cap set bolt
Diameter
74.941 to 74.979 mm (2.9504 to 2.9519 in.)
Pin hole diameter at 20 °C (68°F)
18.013 to 18.016 mm (0.7092 to 0.7093 in.)
Pin diameter
18.001 to 18.004 mm (0.7087 to 0.7088 in.)
Standard pin oil clearance
0.009 to 0.015 mm (0.0004 to 0.0006 in.)
Maximum pin oil clearance
0.050 mm (0.0020 in.)
Standard piston clearance
0.045 to 0.068 mm (0.0018 to 0.0027 in.)
Maximum piston clearance
0.08 mm (0.0032 in.)
No. 1:
Groove clearance
0.02 to 0.07 mm (0.0008 to 0.0028 in.)
No. 2:
Groove clearance
0.02 to 0.06 mm (0.0008 to 0.0024 in.)
Oil:
Groove clearance
0.02 to 0.06 mm (0.0008 to 0.0024 in.)
No. 1:
Standard end gap
0.20 to 0.30 mm (0.0079 to 0.0118 in.)
No. 1:
Maximum end gap
0.61 mm (0.0240 in.)
No. 2:
Standard end gap
0.30 to 0.45 mm (0.0118 to 0.0177 in.)
No. 2:
Maximum end gap
1.20 mm (0.0472 in.)
Oil:
Standard end gap
0.10 to 0.40 mm (0.0039 to 0.0158 in.)
Oil:
Maximum end gap
1.15 mm (0.0453 in.)
Standard diameter
6.6 to 6.7 mm (0.260 to 0.264 in.)
Maximum diameter
6.4 mm (0.252 in.)
Maximum circle runout
0.03 mm (0.0012 in.)
Main journal diameter
45.988 to 46.000 mm (1.8106 to 1.8110 in.)
Main journal taper and out-of-round
0.02 mm (0.0008 in.)
Crank pin diameter
39.992 to 40.000 mm (1.5745 to 1.5748 in.)
Maximum crank pin taper and out-of-round
0.02 mm (0.0008 in.)
Standard:
Crankshaft timing sprocket diameter (w/
chain)
51.72 mm (2.0362 in.)
Maximum:
Crankshaft timing sprocket diameter (w/
chain)
50.5 mm (1.988 in.)
Standard oil clearance
0.01 to 0.023 mm (0.0004 to 0.0009 in.)
Maximum oil clearance
0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
Standard diameter
7.3 to 7.5 mm (0.287 to 0.295 in.)
Minimum diameter
7.3 mm (0.287 in.)
SS–9
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Spark plug x Cylinder head
18
184
13
Ignition coil x Cylinder head cover
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
Idler pulley x Adjust bolt
40
408
30
No. 1 air cleaner inlet x Clamp
3.0
31
27
No. 2 camshaft bearing cap x Cylinder head
13
130
9.6
No. 1 camshaft bearing cap x Cylinder head
23
235
17
Camshaft timing sprocket x No. 2 camshaft
64
653
47
Screw plug x Timing chain cover
15
153
11
Chain vibration damper x Cylinder block
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
Chain tensioner slipper x Cylinder block
9.0
92
80in.*lbf
Chain tensioner x Cylinder block
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
Engine mounting bracket x Timing chain cover
55
561
41
Engine mounting spacer x Body
55
561
41
Engine mounting insulator RH x Engine mounting
bracket
52
530
38
Crankshaft pulley x Crankshaft
128
1,305
95
Cylinder head cover x Cylinder head
10
102
74
Wire harness x Cylinder head cover
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
Windshield washer jar x Body
Bolt A:
4.9
50
43 in.*lbf
Windshield washer jar x Body
Bolt B:
14
143
10
Windshield washer jar x Body
Nut:
5.5
56
49 in.*lbf
Reservoir bracket x Body
8.5
87
75 in.*lbf
Brake master cylinder reservoir x Reservoir bracket
8.5
87
75 in.*lbf
Air cleaner assembly x Cylinder head cover
Bolt:
7.0
71
62 in.*lbf
Air cleaner assembly x Cylinder head cover
Clamp:
3.0
31
27 in.*lbf
Oil control valve filter x Cylinder head
30
306
22
No. 1 taper screw plug x Cylinder head
44
449
33
Cylinder head x Cylinder block
1st: 29
2nd: 90°
3rd: 90°
1st: 296
2nd: 90°
3rd: 90°
1st: 21
2nd: 90°
3rd: 90°
Oil dipstick guide x Intake manifold
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
Water bypass pipe x Cylinder head
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
Engine coolant temperature sensor x Cylinder head
20
204
15
Noise filter x Cylinder head
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
Exhaust manifold x Cylinder head
27
275
20
No. 1 exhaust manifold heat insulator x Exhaust manifold
8.0
82
71 in.*lbf
Knock sensor wire bracket x Cylinder head
9.0
92
80
Flywheel x Crankshaft
49
500
36
Transmission input damper x Flywheel
20
204
15
Starter hole insulator x Hybrid vehicle transaxle
32
326
24
Engine mounting insulator bracket LH x Engine
mounting insulator LH
80
816
59
Front suspension crossmember x Body
Bolt A:
113
1,152
83
Front suspension crossmember x Body
Bolt B:
157
1,602
116
SS
SS–10
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1NZ-FXE ENGINE MECHANICAL
Part Tightened
SS
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Engine moving control rod x Front suspension
crossmember
56
571
41
Engine moving control rod x Hybrid vehicle transaxle
100
1,020
74
Steering sliding yoke x Steering gear
35
357
26
Compressor x Cylinder block
25
255
18
Purge VSV x Engine mounting insulator RH
7.5
76
5.5 in.*lbf
Front wheel x Front axle
103
1,050
76
Connecting rod cap x Connecting rod
1st: 15
2nd: 90°
1st: 153
2nd: 90°
1st: 11
2nd: 90°
Crankshaft bearing cap x Cylinder block
1st: 22
2nd: 90°
1st: 224
2nd: 90°
1st: 16
2nd: 90°
Stud bolt x Cylinder block
5.0
51
44
Oil pan x Cylinder block
24
245
18
Oil strainer x Oil pan
11
112
8.1
No. 2 oil pan x Oil pan
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
Drain plug x No. 2 oil pan
37.5
382
28
Oil filter union x Oil pan
30
306
22
Oil filter x Oil filter union
17.5
178
13
Camshaft timing gear x Camshaft
64
653
47
Camshaft position sensor x Cylinder head
8.0
82
71 in.*lbf
Timing chain cover x Cylinder head and cylinder block
Bolt A: 24
Bolt B: 11
Bolt C: 11
Nut D: 24
Bolt E: 24
Bolt A: 245
Bolt B: 112
Bolt C: 112
Nut D: 245
Bolt E: 245
Bolt A: 18
Bolt B: 8.1
Bolt C: 8.1
Nut D: 18
Bolt E: 18
Water pump x Timing chain cover
11
112
8
Engine mounting bracket x Timing chain cover
55
561
41
Water pump pulley x Water pump
15
153
11
Fuel delivery pipe x Cylinder head
Bolt A: 19
Bolt B: 9.0
Bolt A: 194
Bolt B: 92
Bolt A: 14
Bolt B: 80 in.*lbf
Camshaft timing control valve x Cylinder head
7.5
76
66
Cylinder head cover x Cylinder head
10
102
7
Ventilation valve x Cylinder head cover
27
275
20
Crankshaft position sensor x Timing chain cover
7.5
76
20
Water inlet x Cylinder block
9.0
92
80
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1NZ-FXE FUEL
SS–11
1NZ-FXE FUEL
SERVICE DATA
Fuel injector
Standard resistance
13.45 to 14.15 Ω at 21°C (68°F)
Standard injection volume
Difference between each fuel injector
(Injection volume: 36 to 46 cm3 (2.1 to 2.8 cu
in.))
10 cm3 (0.6 cu in.) or less
SS
SS–12
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1NZ-FXE FUEL
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Fuel injector
Part Tightened
Fuel delivery pipe x
Cylinder head
SS
Bolt A
Bolt B
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
19
194
14
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
Reservoir bracket x Body
8.5
87
75 in.*lbf
Brake master cylinder reservoir x Reservoir bracket
8.5
87
75 in.*lbf
Front outer cowl top panel x Body
6.4
65
57 in.*lbf
No. 2 engine room relay block x Body
8.4
86
74 in.*lbf
Fuel tank
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Canister x Fuel tank
6.0
61
53 in.*lbf
Trap canister with pump
module x Fuel tank
6.0
61
53 in.*lbf
Fuel tank bracket x Fuel tank
6.0
61
53 in.*lbf
Fuel tank x Body
39
400
29
SS–12
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL
1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL
SERVICE DATA
Air fuel ratio sensor
Fuel tank pressure sensor
SS
Voltage
E5-23 (A1A+) - E5-28 (E1)
E5-23 (A1A+) - E5-28 (E1)
3.0 to 3.6 V
2.7 to 3.3 V
Resistance at 20°C(68°F)
1 (HT) - 2 (+B)
2 (+B) - 4 (AF-)
1.8 to 3.4 Ω
10 KΩ or higher
Voltage
1-3
4.5 to 5.5 V
2-3
3.0 to 3.6 V
Purge VSV
Resistance
1-2
26 to 30 Ω at 20°C(68°F)
Heated oxygen sensor
Resistance
1 (HT) - 2 (+B)
1 (HT) - 4 (E)
11 to 16 Ω at 20°C(68°F)
10 KΩ or higher
Canister pressure switching valve
Resistance
1-2
36 to 42 Ω at 20°C(68°F)
1 - body
10 KΩ or higher
2 - body
10 KΩ or higher
SS–13
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1NZ-FXE EMISSION CONTROL
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Canister x Fuel tank sub-assembly
6.0
61
53 in.*lbf
Trap canister x Fuel tank sub-assembly
6.0
61
53 in.*lbf
Purge VSV x Engine mounting insulator sub-assembly
RH
7.5
76
66 in.*lbf
Canister pressure switching valve x Canister
2.9
30
26 in.*lbf
Ventilation valve x Cylinder head cover
27
275
20
Air fuel ratio sensor x Exhaust manifold
: for use with SST
44
449
32
Air fuel ratio sensor x Exhaust manifold
: for use without SST
40
408
30
Heated oxygen sensor x Exhaust manifold
: for use with SST
44
449
32
Heated oxygen sensor x Exhaust manifold
: for use without SST
40
408
30
SS
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1NZ-FXE EXHAUST
SS–13
1NZ-FXE EXHAUST
SERVICE DATA
Compression spring minimum length
Front exhaust pipe assembly x Exhaust
manifold
40.5 mm (1.594 in.)
Tailpipe assembly x Front exhaust pipe
assembly
38.5 mm (1.516 in.)
SS
SS–14
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1NZ-FXE EXHAUST
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part tightened
SS
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Front exhaust pipe x Exhaust manifold
43
440
32
Tail pipe x Front exhaust pipe
43
440
32
Front floor panel brace x Body
30
302
22
SS–14
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1NZ-FXE COOLING
1NZ-FXE COOLING
SERVICE DATA
Thermostat
Valve opening temperature
Valve lift
Radiator cap
80 to 84°C (176 to 183°F)
at 95°C (203°F)
Standard opening pressure
8.5 mm (0.33 in.) or more
74 to 103 kPa (0.75 to 1.05
kgf*cm2, 10.7 to 14.9 psi)
Minimum opening pressure
SS
59 kPa (0.6 kgf*cm2, 8.5 psi)
Fan
Standard amperage
at 20°C (68°F)
9.2 to 11.0 A
Integration relay
Resistance
B1 - B4
10 kΩ or higher
Below 1 Ω (when battery voltage
is applied to terminals 2 and 3)
No. 1 Cooling fan relay
No. 2 cooling fan relay
Resistance
Resistance
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω (when battery voltage
is applied to terminals 1 and 2)
3-4
Below 1 Ω
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-4
10 kΩ or higher (when battery
voltage is applied to terminals 1
and 2)
3-5
Below 1 Ω (when battery voltage
is applied to terminals 1 and 2)
SS–15
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1NZ-FXE COOLING
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Fan x Fan motor
6.2
63
55 in.*lbf
Fan shroud x Radiator
7.5
76
66 in.*lbf
Radiator support x body
5.0
51
44 in.*lbf
Water pump x Cylinder block
11
112
8
Water pump pulley x Water pump
15
153
11
Cooler bracket x Radiator
support
Bolt A
20
204
15
Cooler bracket x Suction
hose
Bolt B
8.5
87
75 in.*lbf
Inverter bracket x Radiator
support
Bolt A
21
214
16
Inverter bracket x Inverter
Bolt B
25
255
18
Radiator temperature switch x Radiator
7.0
71
62 in.*lbf
Radiator support lower LH
x Radiator
Bolt A
5.0
51
44 in.*lbf
Bolt B
3.9
40
35 in.*lbf
Radiator support lower RH
x Radiator
Bolt A
5.0
51
44 in.*lbf
Bolt B
3.9
40
35 in.*lbf
Radiator support upper LH
x Radiator
Bolt A
5.0
51
44 in.*lbf
Bolt B
3.9
40
35 in.*lbf
Radiator support upper
RH x Radiator
Bolt A
5.0
51
44 in.*lbf
Bolt B
Radiator Drain Plug sub-assembly x Radiator
3.9
40
35 in.*lbf
13
129
9.4
Radiator bleeder plug x Radiator
1.5
15
13 in.*lbf
Coolant heat storage tank x Body
19
194
14
Coolant heat storage tank x Coolant heat storage water
pump
6.0
61
53 in.*lbf
SS
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1NZ-FXE LUBRICATION
SS–15
1NZ-FXE LUBRICATION
SERVICE DATA
Oil pressure
Oil pump tip clearance
Oil body tip clearance
at idle speed
at 2,500 rpm
59 kPa (0.6 kgf/cm2, 4.2 psi)
Standard
0.060 to 0.180 mm (0.0024 to 0.0071 in.)
Maximum
0.28 mm (0.0110 in.)
Standard
0.250 to 0.325 mm (0.0098 to 0.0128 in.)
Maximum
0.425 mm (0.0167 in.)
150 to 550 kPa (1.5 to 56 kgf/cm2, 22 to 80
psi)
SS
SS–16
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1NZ-FXE LUBRICATION
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Oil pressure switch x Cylinder block
15
153
11
Stud bolt x Cylinder head
10
102
7
32
11
11
24
24
326
112
112
245
245
24
8
8
18
18
Camshaft timing oil control valve assembly x Cylinder
head
7.5
76
66 in.*lbf
Engine mounting bracket x Cylinder block
55
561
41
Engine mounting bracket x Engine mounting insulator
sub-assembly RH
52
530
38
Crankshaft pulley x Crankshaft
128
1,305
95
Cylinder head cover x Cylinder head
10
102
7
Ignition coil x Cylinder head cover
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
Brake master cylinder reservoir cover x Cylinder head
cover
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
Oil pan drain plug x No. 2 oil pan
38
387
28
Oil pump cover x Oil pump
assembly
Bolt
Screw
8.8
10
90
102
78 in.*lbf
7
Windshield washer jar
assembly x Body
Bolt A
Bolt B
Nut
4.9
14
5.5
50
143
56
43 in.*lbf
10
49 in.*lbf
Brake master cylinder reservoir cover x Reservoir
bracket and reservoir
8.5
87
75 in.*lbf
Reservoir bracket x Body
8.5
87
75 in.*lbf
7.0
3.0
71
31
62 in.*lbf
27 in.*lbf
103
1,050
76
Oil pump assembly x
Cylinder head and block
SS
Air cleaner assembly x
Cylinder head cover
Front wheel RH x Front axle
Bolt A
Bolt B
Bolt C
Nut D
Bolt E
Bolt
Clamp
SS–16
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1NZ-FXE IGNITION
1NZ-FXE IGNITION
SERVICE DATA
Spark plug
SS
Standard electrode gap
1.0 to 1.1 mm (0.039 to 0.043 in.)
Maximum electrode gap
1.2 mm (0.047 in.)
DENSO
SK16R11
NGK
IFR5A11
SS–17
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1NZ-FXE IGNITION
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Engine No. 2 relay block x Cowl
top panel sub assembly
8.4
86
74 in.*lbf
Ignition coil assembly x Cylinder
head cover
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
SS
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1NZ-FXE STARTING
SS–17
1NZ-FXE STARTING
SERVICE DATA
Power switch ( Indicator condition)
Power switch
Key slot
OFF
OFF
ON (ACC)
Green illumination
ON (IG)
Amber illumination
Hybrid system ON
OFF
Push button start system malfunctioning
Flashes continuously in amber
Pushed:
7 (SS2) - 6 (GND)
Below 1 Ω
Pushed:
5 (SS1) - 6 (GND)
Below 1 Ω
Released:
7 (SS2) - 6 (GND)
10 kΩ or higher
Released:
5 (SS1) - 6 (GND)
10 kΩ or higher
Key is in key slot:
3(KSW2) - 2(COM)
10 kΩ or higher
SS
SS–18
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – 1NZ-FXE CHARGING
1NZ-FXE CHARGING
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
SS
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Battery hold down clamp x Body
5.4
55
48 in.*lbf
Battery hold down clamp x
Battery tray
5.4
55
48 in.*lbf
Fusible link block x Battery
6.0
61
53 in.*lbf
No. 2 quarter vent duct x Body
4.0
41
35 in.*lbf
Battery negative terminal x
Battery
6.0
61
53 in.*lbf
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL
SS–19
P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL
SERVICE DATA
Inverter
Converter operation
Water pump with motor
A-2 (GIVA) - A-16 (GINV)
HV Approximately 0 V
A-3 (GIVB) - A-16 (GINV)
Approximately 0 V
A-4 (GUU) - A-16 (GINV)
Approximately 14 to 16 V
A-5 (GVU) - A-16 (GINV)
Approximately 14 to 16 V
A-6 (GWU) - A-16 (GINV)
Approximately14 to 16 V
A-7 (MIVA) - A-16 (GINV)
Approximately 0 V
A-8 (MIVB) - A-16 (GINV)
Approximately 0 V
A-9 (MUU) - A-16 (GINV)
Approximately 14 to 16 V
A-10 (MVU) - A-16 (GINV)
Approximately 14 to 16 V
A-11 (MWU) - A-16 (GINV)
Approximately 14 to 16 V
A-12 (VH) - A-16 (GINV)
Approximately 0.5 V
A-13 (CPWM) - A-32 (GCNV)
Approximately 0 V
A-14 (GSDN) - A-32 (GCNV)
Approximately 2 to 4.5 V
A-15 (VL) - A-32 (GCNV)
Approximately 0.5 V
A-16 (GINV) - C-2 (GND)
Approximately 0 V
A-18 (GIWA) - A-16 (GINV)
Approximately 0 V
A-19 (GIWB) - A-16 (GINV)
Approximately 0 V
A-20 (CT) - A-16 (GINV)
Approximately 0 V
A-21 (GIVT) - A-16 (GINV)
Approximately 2 to 4.5 V
A-22 (GFIV) - A-16 (GINV)
Approximately 5 to 8 V
A-23 (MIWA) - A-16 (GINV)
Approximately 0 V
A-24 (MIWB) - A-16 (GINV)
Approximately 0 V
A-25 (MSDN) - A-16 (GINV)
Approximately 0 V
A-26 (MIVT) - A-16 (GINV)
Approximately 2 to 4.5 V
A-27 (MFIV) - A-16 (GINV)
Approximately 5 to 8 V
A-28 (OVH) - A-16 (GINV)
Approximately 5 to 8 V
A-29 (CSDN) - A-32 (GCNV)
Approximately 0 V
A-30 (FCV) - A-32 (GCNV)
Approximately 13.5 to 16.5 V
A-31 (OVL) - A-32 (GCNV)
Approximately 13.5 to 16.5 V
A-32 (GCNV) - C-2 (GND)
Approximately 0 V
B-1 (ILK) - Body ground
After installing the probe to the terminal,
temporarily install the inverter cover. It does
not have to be tightened with the bolts at this
point.
Below 1 Ω
C-1 (IGCT) - C-2 (GND)
Approximately 8 to 16 V
C-2 (GND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
Auxiliary battery voltage
: READY light ON
14 V
Auxiliary battery voltage
: READY light OFF
12 V
Output current
: READY light ON
Approximately 80 A or less
Battery positive terminal to terminal 1 and the
battery negative terminal to terminal 2
Water pump motor operates properly
SS
SS–20
IGCT relay
SS
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL
7J-1 - 7J-4
HV 10 kΩ or higher
7J-1 - 7K-4
Below 1 Ω
7J-2 - 7J-3
Below 1 Ω
7J-4 - 7K-1
10 kΩ or higher
7J-1 - 7J-4
: When battery voltage is applied to terminals
7J-2 and 7J-3
Below 1 Ω
7J-1 - 7K-1
: When battery voltage is applied to terminals
7J-2 and 7J-3
Below 1 Ω
SS–21
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – P112 HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
MG 1 power cable x MG 1 power cable terminal
8.0
82
71 in.*lbf
MG 2 power cable x MG 2 power cable terminal
8.0
82
71 in.*lbf
No. 1 circuit breaker sensor x Inverter with converter assembly
8.0
82
71 in.*lbf
No. 2 inverter bracket x Inverter with converter assembly
25
255
18
No. 1 inverter bracket x Inverter with converter assembly
25
255
18
Connector bracket x Inverter with converter assembly
8.0
82
71 in.*lbf
Inverter with converter assembly x Body
21
214
16
Inverter cover x Inverter with converter
11
112
8.1
Hybrid control ECU x ECM
5.5
56
49 in.*lbf
Water pump with motor assembly x Body
7.0
71
62 in.*lbf
Frame wire x Floor panel
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
Suspension crossmember x Body
Bolt A:
113
1,152
83
Bolt B:
157
1,601
116
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
No. 1 wire harness protector x Body
Frame wire x Engine room relay block
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
Frame wire x No. 2 system main relay
5.6
57
50 in.*lbf
Frame wire x No. 3 system main relay
5.6
57
50 in.*lbf
Accelerator pedal rod x Body
7.5
77
66 in.*lbf
SS
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL
SS–21
P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL
SERVICE DATA
Battery plug
No. 1 system main relay
No. 2 system main relay
No. 3 system main relay
Resistance between terminals
10 kΩ or higher
Install the service grip:
Resistance between terminals
Below 1 Ω
Positive terminal - Negative terminal
10 kΩ or higher
A-2 (CONT2) - B-2 (CONT2)
Below 1 Ω
A-3 (CONT3) - C-2 (CONT3)
Below 1 Ω
B-1 (GND) - GND
Below 1 Ω
C-1 (GND) - GND
Below 1 Ω
Apply battery voltage between the GND
terminal and CONT1 terminal of the
connector A:
Positive terminal - Negative terminal
Below 1 Ω
A-1 (CONT1) - GND
70 to 160 kΩ
Positive terminal - Negative terminal
10 kΩ or higher
Apply battery voltage between the connector
terminals:
Positive terminal - Negative terminal
Below 1 Ω
Resistance between the connector terminals
20 to 50 kΩ
Positive terminal - Negative terminal
10 kΩ or higher
Apply battery voltage between the connector
terminals:
Positive terminal - Negative terminal
Below 1 Ω
Resistance between the connector terminals
20 to 50 kΩ
System main resistor
Resistance between terminals
18 to 22 Ω
Battery blower relay
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
When battery voltage is applied to terminals 1
and 2:
3-5
Below 1 Ω
Positive probe to terminal 1 (VIB) Negative
probe to terminal 2 (GIB)
3.5 to 4.5 kΩ
Positive probe to terminal 2 (GIB) Negative
probe to terminal 1 (VIB)
5 to 7 kΩ
Positive probe to terminal 1 (VIB) Negative
probe to terminal 3 (IB) A083579E02
3.5 to 4.5 kΩ
Positive probe to terminal 1 (VIB) Negative
probe to terminal 3 (IB)
5 to 7 kΩ
Battery current sensor
SS
SS–22
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – P112 HYBRID BATTERY CONTROL
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
SS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Upper battery carrier x HV battery
5.5
56
49 in.*lbf
Battery cover x HV battery
8.0
82
71 in.*lbf
HV battery x Body
19
194
14
Frame wire x No. 2 system main relay
5.6
57
50 in.*lbf
Frame wire x No. 3 system main relay
5.6
57
50 in.*lbf
No. 6 battery carrier panel x HV battery assembly
7.5
76
66 in.*lbf
Quarter vent duct x Body
4.0
41
35 in.*lbf
Battery bracket reinforcement x Body
28
286
21
Battery bracket reinforcement x HV battery assembly
28
286
21
Battery carrier bracket x Body
28
286
21
Battery carrier bracket x HV battery assembly
28
286
21
No. 2 main battery cable x No. 2 frame wire
5.4
55
48 in.*lbf
No. 2 main battery cable x No. 2 system main relay
5.6
57
50 in.*lbf
Main battery cable x No. 2 frame wire
5.4
55
48 in.*lbf
Main battery cable x No. 3 system main relay
5.6
57
50 in.*lbf
Aluminum shield wire x HV battery
3.3
34
29 in.*lbf
No. 2 frame wire x HV battery
5.4
55
48 in.*lbf
Battery plug x Upper battery carrier
5.4
55
48 in.*lbf
Junction block x HV battery
5.4
55
48 in.*lbf
No. 1 system main relay x Upper battery carrier
3.4
35
30 in.*lbf
Ground terminal x Upper battery carrier
5.6
57
50 in.*lbf
No. 3 system main relay x Upper battery carrier
3.4
35
30 in.*lbf
No. 2 system main relay x Upper battery carrier
3.4
35
30 in.*lbf
System main resistor x Upper battery carrier
3.4
35
30 in.*lbf
Battery current sensor x Upper battery carrier
1.4
14
12 in.*lbf
Battery ECU x Upper battery carrier
3.3
34
29 in.*lbf
Electric vehicle fuse x Service grip
5.4
55
48 in.*lbf
Battery blower x Body
5.0
51
44 in.*lbf
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – HYBRID TRANSAXLE
SS–23
HYBRID TRANSAXLE
SERVICE DATA
Differential case side bearing preload
(Starting torque)
New bearing
0.98 to 1.57 N*m (9.99 to 16.01 kgf*cm, 8.67
to 13.90 in.*lbf)
Reused bearing
0.49 to 0.78 N*m (5.00 to 7.95 kgf*cm, 4.43 to
6.90 in.*lbf)
Differential case side bearing preload
(Turning torque 20 rpm)
Differential preload adjusting shim thickness
0.61 to 1.35 N*m (6.2 to 13.77 kgf*cm, 5.4 to
11.95 in.*lbf)
Mark 1
1.80 mm (0.0709 in.)
Mark 2
1.83 mm (0.0720 in.)
Mark 3
1.86 mm (0.0732 in.)
Mark 4
1.89 mm (0.0744 in.)
Mark 50
1.92 mm (0.0756 in.)
Mark 51
1.94 mm (0.0764 in.)
Mark 52
1.96 mm (0.0772 in.)
Mark 53
1.98 mm (0.0780 in.)
Mark 54
2.00 mm (0.0787 in.)
Mark 55
2.02 mm (0.0795 in.)
Mark 56
2.04 mm (0.0803 in.)
Mark 57
2.06 mm (0.0811 in.)
Mark 58
2.08 mm (0.0819 in.)
Mark 59
2.10 mm (0.0827 in.)
Mark 60
2.12 mm (0.0835 in.)
Mark 61
2.14 mm (0.0843 in.)
Mark 62
2.16 mm (0.0850 in.)
Mark 63
2.18 mm (0.0858 in.)
Mark 64
2.20 mm (0.0866 in.)
Mark 65
2.22 mm (0.0874 in.)
Mark 66
2.24 mm (0.0882 in.)
Mark 67
2.26 mm (0.0890 in.)
Mark 68
2.28 mm (0.0898 in.)
Mark 69
2.30 mm (0.0906 in.)
Mark 70
2.32 mm (0.0913 in.)
Mark 19
2.34 mm (0.0921 in.)
Mark 20
2.37 mm (0.0933 in.)
-
2.40 mm (0.0945 in.)
Mark 22
2.43 mm (0.0957 in.)
Mark 23
2.46 mm (0.0969 in.)
SS
SS–24
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – HYBRID TRANSAXLE
Input shaft shim thickness
SS
Counter drive gear shim thickness
Mark 1
1.00 mm (0.0394 in.)
Mark 2
1.20 mm (0.0472 in.)
Mark 3
1.40 mm (0.0551 in.)
Mark 4
1.60 mm (0.0630 in.)
Mark 5
1.80 mm (0.0709 in.)
Mark 6
2.00 mm (0.0787 in.)
Mark 7
2.20 mm (0.0866 in.)
Mark 8
2.40 mm (0.0945 in.)
Mark 9
2.60 mm (0.1024 in.)
Mark 10
2.80 mm (0.1102 in.)
Mark 11
3.00 mm (0.1181 in.)
Mark 12
3.20 mm (0.1260 in.)
Mark A
2.20 mm (0.0866 in.)
Mark B
2.25 mm (0.0886 in.)
Mark C
2.30 mm (0.0906 in.)
Mark D
2.35 mm (0.0925 in.)
Mark E
2.40 mm (0.0945 in.)
Mark F
2.45 mm (0.0965 in.)
Mark G
2.50 mm (0.0984 in.)
Mark H
2.55 mm (0.1003 in.)
Mark J
2.60 mm (0.1024 in.)
Mark K
2.65 mm (0.1043 in.)
Mark L
2.70 mm (0.1063 in.)
Mark M
2.75 mm (0.1083 in.)
Mark N
2.80 mm (0.1102 in.)
Differential oil seal LH and RH drive in depth
2.7 +-0.5 mm (0.11 +-0.02 in.)
Oil pressure
9.8 kPa (0.1 kgf/cm2, 1.4 pst)
Differential side gear backlash
Standard
Differential side gear washer thickness
0.05 to 0.20 mm (0.0020 to 0.0079 in.)
0.95 mm (0.0374 in.)
1.00 mm (0.0394 in.)
1.05 mm (0.0414 in.)
1.10 mm (0.0433 in.)
1.15 mm (0.0453 in.)
1.20 mm (0.0472 in.)
Sun gear bush diameter
Standard
25.525 to 25.546 mm (1.00492 to 1.00575 in.)
Maximum
25.596 mm (1.00771 in.)
SS–25
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – HYBRID TRANSAXLE
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Oil pump cover x MG2 assembly
5.5
56
49 in.*lbf
Transaxle oil drain plug
39
400
29
Hybrid transaxle assembly x Engine
33
332
24
Coolant drain plug x MG1 assembly
39
400
29
Screw plug x MG1 assembly
55
561
41
Set plug x MG2 assembly
39
400
29
Filler plug x MG2 assembly
39
400
29
MG1 assembly x MG2 assembly
25
250
18
Oil strainer x MG2 assembly
7.9
81
70 in.*lbf
Motor water jacket cover x MG2 assembly
5.5
56
49
Housing tube x MG1 assembly
15
155
11
Detent spring set bolt
9.8
100
86 in.*lbf
Parking cover x MG2 assembly
5.5
56
49 in.*lbf
Parking shaft cover x MG2 assembly
5.5
56
49 in.*lbf
Oil pump cover x plug
7.4
75
65 in.*lbf
Power cable cover x MG1 assembly
4.8
48
42 in.*lbf
Mounting bracket x MG2 assembly
52
530
38
Shift lever assembly x Steering column
8
80
71 in.*lbf
Generator cable x Converter and inverter
5.5
56
49 in.*lbf
Generator cable x MG1 cable cover
5.8
59
51 in.*lbf
Generator cable x MG1 assembly
8.5
87
75 in.*lbf
Connector x MG1 assembly
5.8
59
51 in.*lbf
Connector x MG2 assembly
5.8
59
51 in.*lbf
Transmission case cover x MG2 assembly
7.0
71
62 in.*lbf
Shift control actuator x MG2 assembly
16
160
12
Shift lever assembly x Body
12
122
9
Engine hanger x Hybrid transaxle assembly
38
387
28
Stay x Hybrid transaxle assembly
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
Engine mounting bracket No.3 x Hybrid transaxle assembly
52
530
38
Housing side cover x Hybrid transaxle assembly
32
326
23
Engine mounting insulator x Hybrid transaxle assembly
80
816
59
Earth wire x Hybrid transaxle assembly
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
Set plug x MG2 assembly
39
400
29
Screw plug x MG2 assembly
13
130
9
Nut x Baring
280
2860
207
SS
SS–26
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – DRIVE SHAFT
DRIVE SHAFT
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
SS
Part Tightened
N.m
kgf.cm
ft.lbf
Front axle hub nut
216
2200
159
Front wheel set nut
103
1050
76
transaxle x drain plug
39
398
29
Flexible hose and speed sensor
front x Shock absorber assembly
front
29
300
22
Speed sensor front x Steering
knuckle
8.0
82
71 in.lbf
Tie rod end sub-assembly x
Steering knuckle
49
500
36
Suspension arm sub-assembly
lower No.1 x Steering knuckle
89
908
66
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – AXLE
SS–27
AXLE
SERVICE DATA
Front axle hub bearing: Backlash
Maximum: 0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
Front axle hub sub-assembly: Deviation
Maximum: 0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
Rear axle hub & bearing assembly: Backlash
Maximum: 0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
Rear axle hub & bearing assembly: Deviation
Maximum: 0.07 mm (0.0028 in.)
SS
SS–28
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – AXLE
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
SS
Part Tightened
N.m
kgf.cm
ft.lbf
Front axle hub nut
216
2200
159
Front wheel set nut
103
1050
76
Rear wheel set nut
103
1050
76
Front axle assembly x Shock
absorber assembly front
153
1560
113
Speed sensor front x Steering
knuckle
8.0
82
71 in.lbf
Tie rod end sub-assembly x
Steering knuckle
49
500
36
Suspension arm sub-assembly
lower No.1 x Steering knuckle
89
908
66
Front disc brake caliper assembly
x Steering knuckle
109
1114
81
Rear axle hub & bearing
assembly x Rear axle beam
61
622
45
Steering knuckle x Lower ball joint
assembly
71
724
52
Steering knuckle x Front axle hub
56
571
41
SS–28
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – SUSPENSION
SUSPENSION
SERVICE DATA
Front wheel alignment
SS
Vehicle height
A-B:
D-C:
95 mm (3.74 in.)
62 mm (2.40 in.)
Toe-in (total)
Rack end length difference
0° +-12' (0° +-0.2°, 0 +-2 mm, 0 +0.08 in.)
1.5 mm (0.059 in.) or less
Wheel angle
Inside wheel
40° 35' +-2°
(40.58° +-2°)
Outside wheel: Reference
Rear wheel alignment
Front suspension
34°15'
(34.25°)
Camber
Right-left error
-0° 35' +-45' (-0.58° +-0.75°)
45' (0.75°) or less
Caster
Right-left error
3°10' +-45' (3.17° +-0.75°)
45' (0.75°) or less
Steering axis inclination
Right-left error
12°35' +-45' (12.58° +-0.75°)
45' (0.75°) or less
Toe-in (total)
0°18' +-15' (0.30° +-0.25°, 3.0 +2.5 mm, 0.12 +-0.10 in.)
Camber
Right-left error
-1°30' +-30' (-1.50 +-0.5°)
30' (0.5°) or less
Lower ball joint turning torque
0.98 to 4.90 N*m (10 to 50
kgf*cm, 8.7 to 43 in.*lbf)
Stabilizer link turning torque
0.05 to 1.96 N*m (0.5 to 20
kgf*cm, 0.4 to 17.4 in.*lbf)
A:
Ground clearance of front wheel center
B:
Ground clearance of lower arm No.1 set bolt center
C:
Ground clearance of rear axle carrier bush set bolt
center
D:
Ground clearance of rear wheel center
SS–29
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – SUSPENSION
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Tie rod end lock nut
74
755
55
Steering knuckle x Shock
absorber
153
1,560
113
Front wheel hub nut
103
1,050
76
Suspension support x Piston rod
47
479
35
Suspension support x Body
39
398
29
ABS speed sensor wire harness
bracket set bolt
19
192
14
Steering gear x Suspension cross
member
58
591
43
Stabilizer link x Shock absorber
with coil spring
74
755
55
Steering knuckle x Lower ball joint
71
724
52
Lower suspension arm x
Suspension cross member
137
1,400
101
Stabilizer bracket No.1 x
Suspension cross member
19
194
14
Rear wheel hub nut
103
1,050
76
Piston rod set nut
56
571
41
Shock absorber with coil spring x
Body
80
816
59
Shock absorber with coil spring x
Rear axle beam
80
816
59
Parking brake cable set bolt
5.4
55
48 in.*lbf
Rear axle hub set bolt
61
622
45
Skid control sensor wire set bolt
5.0
51
44 in.*lbf
Rear axle beam x Body
85
867
63
Stabilizer bar x Rear axle beam
149
1,520
110
SS
SS–30
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – TIRE AND WHEEL
TIRE AND WHEEL
SERVICE DATA
Cold tire inflation pressure
185/65R15 86S
Front:
Rear:
SS
240 kPa (2.4 kgf/cm2, 35 psi)
230 kPa (2.3 kgf/cm2, 33 psi)
Tire runout
1.4 mm (0.055 in.) or less
Imbalance after adjustment
8.0 g (0.018 lb) or less
SS–31
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – TIRE AND WHEEL
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Tire pressure warning receiver x
Body
7.5
76
66 in.*lbf
Tire pressure warning valve set
nut
4.0
41
35 in.*lbf
Tire pressure warning ECU set
bolt
7.5
76
66 in.*lbf
SS
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – BRAKE CONTROL
SS–31
BRAKE CONTROL
SERVICE DATA
Brake pedal stroke sensor
0.8 to 1.2 V
SS
SS–32
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – BRAKE CONTROL
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Brake actuator
SS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Brake line union nut
15
155
11
Brake actuator x No. 2 brake
actuator bracket
18
184
13
Brake actuator x Gusset
7.5
76
66 in.*lbf
Brake actuator x bracket
18
184
13
Brake actuator x Brake actuator
damper
18
184
13
Brake actuator w/ gusset x Body
20
200
15
Brake actuator x Brake tube
clamp bracket
5.0
51
44 in.*lbf
Brake actuator tube set nut
8.5
87
75 in.*lbf
No. 1 front brake tube set bolt
5.0
51
44 in.*lbf
Brake actuator bracket x No. 5
front brake tube bracket
5.0
51
44 in.*lbf
Brake actuator resistor set nut
5.0
51
44 in.*lbf
Front speed sensor
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Front speed sensor set bolt
8.0
82
71 in.*lbf
Front speed sensor wire clamp x
Body
8.0
82
71 in.*lbf
Front speed sensor wire clamp x
Shock absorber
19
192
14
Wheel nut
103
1,050
76
Yaw rate sensor
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Yaw rate sensor set bolt
19
194
14
Skid control ECU
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Skid control ECU set nut
5.0
51
44 in.*lbf
Brake control power supply
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Brake control power supply
assembly set bolt
19
194
14
Brake pedal stroke sensor
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Brake pedal stroke sensor set
bolt
9.3
95
82 in.*lbf
SS–32
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – BRAKE
BRAKE
SERVICE DATA
SS
Brake pedal height from asphalt sheet
138 to 148 mm (5.433 to 5.827 in.)
Brake pedal stroke sensor
0.8 to 1.2 V
Brake pedal free play
0.5 to 4 mm (0.02 to 0.16 in.)
Stop light switch clearance
0.5 to 2.4 mm (0.020 to 0.095 in.)
Brake pedal reserve distance from asphalt sheet at 196 N (20 kgf, 44.1 lbf)
More than 104 mm (4.1 in.)
Front brake pad lining thickness
Standard
11.0 mm (0.433 in.)
Minimum
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
Front brake disc thickness
Standard
22.0 mm (0.866 in.)
Minimum
20.0 mm (0.787 in.)
Front brake disc runout
Maximum
0.05 mm (0.0020 in.)
Rear brake drum inside diameter
Standard
200.0 mm (7.874 in.)
Maximum
201.0 mm (7.913 in.)
Standard
4.0 mm (0.157 in.)
Minimum
1.0 mm (0.039 in.)
Rear drum brake shoe lining thickness
Rear brake drum and rear brake shoe clearance
0.6 mm (0.024 in.)
SS–33
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – BRAKE
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Brake pedal
Part tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Brake pedal support x Body
13
130
9
Brake pedal support x Instrument
panel reinforcement
24
241
18
Brake pedal shaft nut
37
375
27
Stop light switch lock nut
26
265
19
Brake pedal stroke sensor set
bolt
9.3
95
82 in.*lbf
Brake master cylinder
Part tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Brake line union nut
15
155
11
No. 1 front brake tube set bolt
5.0
51
44 in.*lbf
No. 5 front brake tube set bolt
5.0
51
44 in.*lbf
No. 1 brake master cylinder union
set screw
1.8
18
16 in.*lbf
Push rod clevis lock nut
26
265
19
Brake master cylinder subassembly set nut
13
127
9
Brake stroke simulator cylinder
Part tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Brake stroke simulator stud bolt
5.0
51
44 in.*lbf
Brake stroke simulator x Bracket
6.0
61
53 in.*lbf
Brake stroke simulator bracket x
Body
8.5
87
75 in.*lbf
Brake stroke simulator x Brake
actuator tube assembly
8.5
87
75 in.*lbf
Brake line union nut
15
155
11
Front brake
Part tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Front disc brake cylinder
mounting set bolt
109
1,114
81
Front disc brake cylinder x Front
disc brake cylinder mounting
34
347
25
Flexible hose union bolt
33
337
24
Bleeder plug
8.4
86
74 in.*lbf
Wheel nut
103
1,050
76
Part tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Rear wheel brake cylinder x
Backing plate
9.8
100
87 in.*lbf
Brake line union nut
15
155
11
Bleeder plug
8.5
85
73 in.*lbf
Wheel nut
103
1,050
76
Rear drum brake
SS
SS–34
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – PARKING BRAKE
PARKING BRAKE
SERVICE DATA
Parking brake pedal travel at 300 N (31 kgf, 68.3 lbf)
SS
6 to 9 clicks
SS–35
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – PARKING BRAKE
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Parking brake control pedal set
bolt and nut
20
204
15
No. 1 parking brake cable lock nut
5.4
55
48 in.*lbf
No. 1 parking brake cable set bolt
and nut
14
143
10
No. 2 parking brake cable clamp
bolt
5.4
55
48 in.*lbf
No. 2 parking brake cable retainer
bolt
6.0
61
53 in.*lbf
No. 2 parking brake cable x
Backing plate
8.0
82
71 in.*lbf
No. 3 parking brake cable clamp
bolt
5.4
55
48 in.*lbf
No. 3 parking brake cable retainer
bolt
6.0
61
53 in.*lbf
No. 3 parking brake cable x
Backing plate
8.0
82
71 in.*lbf
Parking brake cable heat
insulator set nut
5.4
55
48 in.*lbf
Parking brake intermediate lever
adjusting nut
12.5
127
9
Wheel nut
103
1,050
76
SS
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – STEERING COLUMN
SS–35
STEERING COLUMN
SERVICE DATA
Steering wheel free play
Maximum
30 mm (1.18 in.)
SS
SS–36
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – STEERING COLUMN
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
SS
Part tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Steering column assembly set
bolt
25
255
18
Power steering motor set bolt
18
185
13
Steering intermediate shaft
assembly No. 2 x Steering
column assembly
35
360
26
Steering intermediate shaft
assembly No. 2 x Steering sliding
yoke sub-assembly
35
360
26
Steering sliding yoke subassembly x Steering intermediate
shaft assembly
35
360
26
Steering wheel set nut
50
510
37
Tilt lever bracket set screw
2.0
20
37
Steering wheel pad set screw
(Torx screw)
8.8
90
78 in.*lbf
Power steering motor assembly x
Steering column assembly
18
185
18 in.*lbf
Power steering ECU assembly
5
50
44 in.*lbf
Tie rod end lock nut
74
750
54
SS–36
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – POWER STEERING
POWER STEERING
SERVICE DATA
STEERING WHEEL
SS
Steering effort
(Reference)
5.5 N*m (56 kgf*cm, 49 in.*lbf)
Steering wheel free play
Maximum
30 mm (1.18 in.)
POWER STEERING GEAR
Tie rod end sub-assembly total preload
(Turning)
2.0 N*m (20.4 kgf*cm, 18 in.*lbf) or less
Steering gear assembly total preload
(Turning)
0.6 - 1.2 N*m (6.1 - 12.2 kgf*cm, 5 - 11 in.*lbf)
Steering rack boot clamp clearance
3.0 mm (0.12 in.) or less
SS–37
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – POWER STEERING
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
50
510
37
Power steering rack x Steering
rack end sub-assembly
60 (83)
612 (846)
44 (61)
Tie rod assembly lock nut
74
749
54
Steering gear assembly set bolt
58
591
43
Steering intermediate shaft x
Steering gear assembly
35
360
26
Front stabilizer bracket No. 1
19
194
14
Front stabilizer link assembly set
nut
74
755
55
Steering sliding yoke subassembly set bolt
35
360
26
STEERING WHEEL
Steering wheel set nut
POWER STEERING GEAR
Tie rod end sub-assembly set nut
74
749
54
Hub nut
103
1,050
76
( ): For use without SST
SS
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – AIR CONDITIONING
SS–37
AIR CONDITIONING
SERVICE DATA
Refrigerant charge volume
Standard: 450 +- 50 g (15.87 +- 1.76 oz.)
SS
SS–38
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – AIR CONDITIONING
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
REFRIGERANT LINE
SS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Suction hose sub-assembly x
Electric inverter compressor
assembly
9.8
100
87 in.*lbf
Discharge hose sub-assembly x
Electric inverter compressor
assembly
9.8
100
87 in.*lbf
Discharge hose sub-assembly x
Condenser assembly
5.4
55
49 in.*lbf
Cooler refrigerant liquid pipe Ex
Condenser assembly
5.4
55
49 in.*lbf
AIR CONDITIONING UNIT
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Air conditioning tube and
accessory assembly x Air
conditioning unit assembly
3.5
35
30 in.*lbf
ELECTRIC INVERTER COMPRESSOR
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Electric inverter compressor
assembly x Engine
25
255
18
Suction hose sub-assembly x
Electric inverter compressor
assembly
9.8
100
87 in.*lbf
Discharge hose sub-assembly x
Electric inverter compressor
assembly
9.8
100
87 in.*lbf
CONDENSER
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Discharge hose sub-assembly x Condenser assembly
5.4
55
49 in.*lbf
Cooler refrigerant liquid pipe Ex Condenser assembly
5.4
55
49 in.*lbf
Radiator support bracket
sub-assembly upper RH
Bolt A
5.0
51
44 in.*lbf
Bolt B
3.9
40
35 in.*lbf
Bolt C
7.5
76
66 in.*lbf
Bolt A
5.0
51
44 in.*lbf
Radiator support bracket
sub-assembly upper RH
Bolt B
3.9
40
35 in.*lbf
Bolt C
7.5
76
66 in.*lbf
SS–38
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT SYSTEM
SUPPLEMENTAL RESTRAINT
SYSTEM
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
Steering pad x Steering wheel assembly
SS
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
8.8
90
78 in.*lbf
Curtain shield airbag assembly set bolt
11
110
8
Front passenger airbag assembly x Body
20
204
15
Center airbag sensor x Body
Front airbag sensor x Body
17.5
178
13
RH Side:
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
LH Side:
17.5
178
13
Side airbag sensor x Body
9.0
92
80 in.*lbf
Rear airbag sensor x Body
17.5
178
13
Seat position sensor x Front seat assembly
8.0
82
71 in.*lbf
SS–39
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – SEAT BELT
SEAT BELT
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
FRONT SEAT BELT
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Front seat inner belt assembly
x Front seat
42
428
31
Front seat outer belt assembly
(Upper part of retractor) x Body
5.0
51
44 in.*lbf
Front seat outer belt assembly
(Lower part of retractor) x Body
42
428
31
Front seat outer belt assembly
(shoulder anchor) x Body
42
428
31
Front seat outer belt assembly
(floor anchor) x Body
42
428
31
Front shoulder belt anchor
adjuster assembly x Body
42
428
31
REAR SEAT BELT
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Child restraint seat anchor
bracket sub-assembly x Body
42
428
31
Rear seat inner belt assembly
center x Body
42
428
31
Rear seat inner Belt Assembly
RH x Body
42
428
31
Rear seat belt assembly outer
center (retractor side.) x Body
42
428
31
Rear seat belt assembly outer
center (for Floor Anchor) x
Body
42
428
31
Rear seat outer belt assembly
RH (retractor) x Body
42
428
31
Rear seat outer belt assembly
RH (floor anchor side) x Body
42
428
31
Rear seat outer belt RH (floor
anchor side.) x Body
42
428
31
SS
SS–40
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – WIPER AND WASHER
WIPER AND WASHER
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
SS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft*lbf
Wiper motor x Wiper link
5.4
5.5
48 in. lbf
Wiper motor x Crank arm
17
175
13
Wiper link x Body
5.5
56
49 in. lbf
Wiper arm x Wiper link
21
214
15
Rear wiper motor x Body
5.5
56
49 in. lbf
Rear wiper motor x Rear wiper
arm
5.5
56
49 in. lbf
SS–41
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – AUDIO / VISUAL
AUDIO / VISUAL
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft*lbf
Antenna holder assembly x
antenna nut
5.0
51
44 in. lbf
Antenna cord x bolt
7.0
71
62 in. lbf
SS
SS–42
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – HORN
HORN
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
HORN
SS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Low pitched horn x Body
20
204
15
High pitched horn x Body
20
204
15
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS
SS–43
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
WINDSHIELD/WINDOWGLASS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Wiper arm x Body
21
214
15
w/ Rear Wiper Rear wiper arm x
Body
5.5
56
49 in.*lbf
SS
SS–44
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – MIRROR
MIRROR
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
MIRROR
SS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Outer rear view mirror
assembly x Door panel
5.5
56
49 in.*lbf
SS–45
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – INSTRUMENT PANEL
INSTRUMENT PANEL
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Instrument panel reinforcement x
Passenger airbag
20
204
15
SS
SS–46
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – SEAT
SEAT
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Front Seat Assembly
SS
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Airbag sensor x Seat adjuster
frame
8.0
82
71 in.*lbf
Seatback cover bracket x Seat
adjuster frame (w/ front seat
side airbag)
5.5
56
49 in.*lbf
Inner belt x Seat adjuster frame
42
428
31
Seat x Body
37
377
27
Part Tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Seatback hinge x Seatback
frame
36.8
375
27
Seatback center hinge x
Seatback frame
36.8
375
27
Seatback hinge x Body
18.1
185
13
Seatback center hinge x Body
18.1
185
13
Seatback lock x Seatback
frame
18.1
185
13
Rear seat outer belt center x
Seatback frame
42
428
31
Rear seat outer belt center
(floor anchor) x Body
42
428
31
Rear Seat Assembly
SS–47
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – ENGINE HOOD / DOOR
ENGINE HOOD / DOOR
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Part tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
HOOD
Hood hinge x Hood
13
133
10
Hood hinge x Body
5.5
56
49 in.*lbf
Hood lock x Hood
8.0
82
71 in.*lbf
Door check x Body
30
306
22
Door check x Door panel
5.5
56
49 in.*lbf
Door frame sub-assembly rear
lower x Door panel
8.0
82
71 in.*lbf
Door glass x Front door window
regulator
5.5
56
49 in.*lbf
Door hinge x Body
26
265
19
Door hinge x Door panel
26
265
19
FRONT DOOR
Door lock x Door panel
5.0
51
44 in.*lbf
Door lock striker x Body
23
235
17
Door outside handle cover x Door
panel
7.0
71
62 in.*lbf
Door outside handle frame x Door
panel
4.0
41
35 in.*lbf
Outer view mirror x Door panel
10
102
7
Window regulator x Door panel
8.0
82
71 in.*lbf
Door check x Body
30
306
22
Door check x Door panel
5.5
56
49 in.*lbf
Door hinge x Body
26
265
19
REAR DOOR
Door hinge x Door panel
26
265
19
Door lock x Door panel
5.0
51
44 in.*lbf
Door lock striker x Body
23
235
17
Door outside handle cover x Door
panel
4.0
41
35 in.*lbf
Door outside handle frame x Door
panel
7.0
71
62 in.*lbf
Window division bar subassembly x Door panel
5.5
56
49 in.*lbf
Back door femaie stopper x Door
panel
5.5
56
49 in.*lbf
Back door hinge assembly x Body
19.5
200
14
Back door hinge assembly x Door
panel
19.5
200
14
Back door lock assembly x Door
panel
8.0
82
71 in.*lbf
Back door lock striker x Body
11.5
120
8.0
Back door stay sub-assembly x
Body
7.0
71
62 in.*lbf
Back door stay sub-assembly x
Door panel
22
224
16
Center stop light assembly x Door
panel
5.5
56
49 in.*lbf
BACK DOOR (LIFTBACK MODEL)
SS
SS–48
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – EXTERIOR
EXTERIOR
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Front Bumper
SS
Part tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Front bumper reinforcement x
Body
67
683
49
Radiator grille protector x Body
5.0
51
44 in.*lbf
SS–49
SERVICE SPECIFICATIONS – INTERIOR
INTERIOR
TORQUE SPECIFICATIONS
Roof Headlining
Part tightened
N*m
kgf*cm
ft.*lbf
Front seat outer belt (floor
anchor) x Body
42
430
31
Rear seat 3 point type belt
(floor anchor) x Body
42
430
31
SS
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
ST–1
SMART KEY SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
NOTICE:
• When disconnecting the cable from the negative (-)
battery terminal, initialize the following system(s) after
the cable is reconnected.
System Name
See Procedure
Power Window Control System
IN-32
• When the warning light is illuminated or the battery
has been disconnected and reconnected, pressing the
power switch may not start the system on the first try.
If so, press the power switch again.
• When the power source control ECU is replaced with a
new ECU and the battery's negative (-) terminal is
reconnected, the power switch automatically turns ON
(IG). However, when the power source control ECU is
removed and then reinstalled, the power switch
remains in the same mode as when the ECU was
removed.
ST
ST–2
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
- BODY ECU
- IG1 RELAY
- AM1 FUSE
POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU
POWER SWITCH
TRANSPONDER KEY ECU
GATEWAY ECU
HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
ST
ACC RELAY
TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU
KEY SLOT
STOP LIGHT SWITCH ASSEMBLY
B128128E01
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
ST–3
ENGINE ROOM JUNCTION BLOCK
- IG2 RELAY
- AM2 FUSE
ST
B128129E01
ST–4
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
Key
Key Slot
Transponder Key
Amplifier and Coil
Halfway Switch
Power Switch
Full Switch
Key Interlock Solenoid
Transponder
Key ECU
Serial Communication
ACC Relay
ST
BEAN
Transmission
Control ECU
IG1 Relay
Power
Source
Control
ECU
IG2 Relay
Stop Light Switch
Certification ECU*
Combination Meter
- Vehicle Speed
Gateway ECU
CAN
Hybrid Vehicle
Control ECU
)
*: w/ Smart Key System (for door lock)
B128116E01
ST–5
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
Sender
Receiver
Signal
Line
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
Power source control ECU
•
BEAN
•
•
Shift position signal (power
source control)
Drive OK signal (power stop
control)
Stop switch signal (power
source control)
Meter
Power source control ECU
Vehicle speed signal (power
source control)
BEAN
Body ECU
Power source control ECU
•
•
•
BEAN
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
•
Diagnosis erasure
Diagnostic tool request
Door lock position signal
(driver, passenger and rear
doors) (power switch
illumination control)
Courtesy switch signal
(driver, passenger and rear
doors) (power switch
illumination control)
Vehicle model signal (power
source control switch)
IG switch signal (power
source control)
ACC switch signal (power
source control)
Key switch signal (key lock
control)
Fading dome light illumination
request signal (power switch
illumination control)
Taillight illumination signal
(power switch illumination
control)
All doors courtesy switch
signal (power switch
illumination control)
ST
Steering lock ECU
Power source control ECU
Immobiliser information signal
(power source control)
BEAN
Power source control ECU
Body ECU
Power switch signal (for security
cancel)
BEAN
Power source control ECU
Steering lock ECU
•
Immobiliser ID match request
signal (ID match start at
power ON)
Key insertion status signal
(for immobiliser control)
BEAN
P status signal (key interlock
control)
P control ECU malfunctioning
status signal (power source
control, key lock control)
Auto P cancel signal (power
source control, key lock
control)
NP status signal (power
source control, key lock
control)
Auto P OK signal (power
source control, key lock
control)
BEAN
Immobiliser ID match request
signal (smart ignition control)
Key insertion status signal
(smart ignition control)
Key code confirmation signal
(wireless control)
BEAN
•
Transmission control ECU
Power source control ECU
•
•
•
•
•
Certification ECU
Power source control ECU
•
•
•
Theft warning ECU
Power source control ECU
Power switch signal (for security
set and cancel)
BEAN
ST–6
ST
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
Sender
Receiver
Signal
Line
Power source control ECU
Transmission control ECU
Power source OFF ready signal
(power source AUTO OFF
control)
BEAN
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
ST–7
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
SMART KEY SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
(a) The smart key system uses a push-type power
switch, which the driver operates by inserting a key
into the key slot or by merely carrying the key*. This
system consists of a power source control ECU,
power switch, key slot, key, ACC relay, IG1 relay,
IG2 relay and transponder key ECU. The power
source control ECU controls the system. This
system operates in conjunction with the engine
immobiliser system and the smart key system*.
The table below shows the transition of the power
switch, which depends on whether the brake pedal
is depressed or released.
HINT:
*: w/ Smart key system (for door lock)
Brake Pedal Operation
Power Switch Operation
Released
Power mode changes between OFF, ON (ACC) and ON (IG) power
switch is pressed
Depressed
Power mode changes to ON (READY) from any power mode
2.
FUNCTION OF COMPONENT
Components
Function
Key
•
•
Key slot
•
•
•
•
Power switch
•
•
•
•
•
IG1 relay
IG2 relay
ACC relay
When driver inserts key into key slot, built-in transponder chip
transmits ID code signal to transponder key amplifier which is
provided in key slot.
For a vehicle with smart entry system (for door lock), if driver
operates power switch with key in driver's possession, key
receives signals from oscillators and transmits ID code to door
control receiver.
Halfway switch:
Detects whether key is inserted and outputs signal to transponder
key ECU.
Full switch:
Detects whether key is inserted and outputs signal to power
source control ECU.
Transponder key amplifier and coil:
Receives ID code signal from transponder chip which is built into
key, and outputs it to transponder key ECU.
Key interlock solenoid:
Power source control ECU operates this solenoid in accordance
with power switch mode and shift position to keep key locked in
key slot.
In accordance with shift position and stop light switch's condition,
changes power modes in 4 stages as follows: OFF, ON (ACC),
ON (IG) and ON (READY).
Power mode can be determined by illumination / flash / color of
power switch indicator. Push button start system malfunctions can
also be determined.
Operates in accordance with power source control ECU to supply
power to respective system.
Stop light switch
Outputs brake pedal's status to power source control ECU.
Parking lock actuator
•
•
Power source control ECU
Operates in accordance with signals from transmission control
ECU to actuate parking lock mechanism.
Detects actuation status of parking lock (whether shift position is P
or other position) and outputs it to transmission control ECU.
Controls push button start system in accordance with signals received
from switches and ECUs.
ST
ST–8
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
Components
Function
Transponder key ECU
•
•
•
•
Transmission control ECU
•
•
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
•
•
Certification ECU*
Actuates parking lock actuator upon receiving power switch OFF
signal from power source control ECU.
Transmits actuation status of parking lock (whether shift position
is P or other position) to power source control ECU.
Starts hybrid control system in accordance with system start
signal received from power source control ECU.
Receives hybrid control system start authorization signal from
transponder key ECU.
Checks ID code received from door control receiver and transmits
check results to transponder key ECU.
3.
ST
Controls engine immobiliser system by recognizing key ID code
transmitted by transponder key amplifier.
Receives ID code check results from certification ECU*.
Transmits key ID code check results to power source control
ECU.
Transmits hybrid control system start authorization signal to
hybrid vehicle control ECU.
HINT:
*: w/ Smart key system (for door lock)
SYSTEM FUNCTION
The electric controls of the smart key system are
described below:
Control
Outline
Power switch control
(w/o smart key system (for door lock))
Transponder key ECU checks ID code when key is inserted into key
slot. Power source control ECU verifies check results and authorizes
operation of switch.
Power switch control
(w/ smart key system (for door lock))
•
•
When driver operates power switch with key in driver's
possession, power source control ECU starts indoor electrical key
oscillator, which transmits request signal to key. Upon receiving
this signal, key transmits ID code signal to certification ECU.
Transponder key ECU verifies check results received from
certification ECU via BEAN and sends them to power source
control ECU. Based on these results, power source control ECU
authorizes operation of power switch.
Auto P control
While shift position is not P, if power switch is turned OFF, hybrid
vehicle control ECU commands transmission control ECU to activate
parking lock actuator and change shift position to P.
Diagnosis
When power source control ECU detects malfunction, power source
control ECU diagnoses and memorizes malfunction.
4.
POWER SWITCH CONTROL (WITH KEY)
• When a key is inserted into the key slot and the
transponder key ECU recognizes the ID code of the
key, the power source control ECU authorizes
operation of the power switch.
• A power mode (OFF, ON (ACC) and ON (IG)) can be
selected by pressing the power switch. Press, release
and press the power switch until the desired power
mode is selected (the power mode cycle in the order
shown above). If the driver pushes the power switch
while depressing the brake pedal (the stop light switch
turns ON), the power mode will change to ON
(READY) regardless of the previous power mode.
• After approximately 1 hour has passed with the power
switch ON (ACC) and the shift position in P, the power
source control ECU will automatically turns OFF the
power (the power mode changes to OFF).
ST–9
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
• The illustration below shows the transition of power
modes.
Shift Position
Except P
P
Power Switch
Power Switch
Power Switch
with Brake
Power Switch
Power Switch
with Brake
Shift position is moved to P
automatically
OFF
ON (ACC)
ON (IG)
ST
ON (READY)
: Transition of Power Mode
(only with vehicle stopped)
: Transition of Power Mode
)
B128117E01
5.
HINT:
While the vehicle is being driven normally, operation of
the power switch is disabled. However, if the hybrid
control system must be stopped in an emergency while
the vehicle is being driven, pressing the power switch for
at least 3 seconds can stop the hybrid control system.
Power mode changes from ON (READY) to ON (ACC).
DIAGNOSIS
If a malfunction occurs in the IG circuit, the power source
control ECU will perform the controls listed in the table
below and record a DTC.
IG Circuit Malfunction
Details
Malfunction occurs during ON (IG) mode
•
•
•
Hold circuit in power source control ECU continues to supply
power to IG1 and IG2 relays. At this time, power source control
ECU begins flashing amber-colored indicator on power switch.
After power switch is set to OFF, power source control ECU
continues flashing indicator on power switch for 15 seconds.
Hybrid system cannot be restarted.
ST–10
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
IG Circuit Malfunction
Details
Malfunction occurs during ON (ACC) or OFF mode
•
•
•
ST
When power switch is set to ON (IG) and malfunction is detected,
power switch automatically turns OFF.
If same malfunction as above is detected continuously 3 times,
power source control ECU begins flashing amber-colored
indicator on power switch for 15 seconds.
Hybrid system cannot be restarted.
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
ST–11
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
• Use this procedure to troubleshoot the smart key system.
• *: Use the intelligent tester.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
INSPECT COMMUNICATION FUNCTION OF LARGE-SCALE MULTIPLEX
COMMUNICATION SYSTEM (BEAN)*
(a) Use the intelligent tester to check if Multiplex
Communication System (MPX) is functioning normally.
Result
Result
Proceed to
MPX DTC is not output
A
MPX DTC is output
B
B
GO TO MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION
SYSTEM
A
3
ST
CHECK FOR DTC*
(a) Check for DTC and note any codes that are output.
(b) Delete the DTC.
(c) Recheck for DTCs. Try to prompt the DTC by simulating
the original activity that the DTC suggests.
Result
Result
Proceed to
The DTC does not reoccur
A
The DTC reoccurs
B
B
Go to step 6
A
4
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Result
Result
Proceed to
Fault is not listed in problem symptoms table
A
Fault is listed in problem symptoms table
B
B
Go to step 6
ST–12
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
A
5
OVERALL ANALYSIS AND TROUBLESHOOTING*
(a) DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST (see page ST-16)
(1) Inspection with the intelligent tester (DATA LIST)
(2) Inspection with the intelligent tester (ACTIVE TEST)
(b) On-vehicle Inspection (see page ST-18)
(c) Terminal of ECU (see page ST-11)
NEXT
6
ADJUST, REPAIR OR REPLACE
NEXT
7
NEXT
END
ST
CONFIRMATION TEST
ST–13
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
Use the table below to help determine the cause of the
problem symptom. The potential causes of the symptoms are
listed in order of probability in the "Suspected Area" column
of the table. Check each symptom by checking the suspected
areas in the order they are listed. Replace parts as
necessary.
Smart key system
Symptom
Power mode does not change to ON (IG and ACC)
Power mode does not change to ON (ACC)
Power mode does not change to ON (IG)
Power mode does not change to ON (READY)
Suspected area
See page
1. Power source control ECU
-
2. AM1 fuse
-
3. AM2 fuse
-
4. Power switch
ST-74
5. Key slot
ST-77
6. Wire harness
ST-47
1. Power source control ECU
-
2. AM1 fuse
-
3. AM2 fuse
-
4. ACC relay
-
5. Wire harness
ST-61
1. Power source control ECU
-
2. AM1 fuse
-
3. AM2 fuse
-
4. IG1 relay
-
5. IG2 relay
-
6. Wire harness
ST-54
1. Power source control ECU
-
2. Stop light switch
LI-111
3. Wire harness
ST-66
ST
ST–14
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
CHECK POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU
P6
B075721E23
(a) Disconnect the P6 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance and voltage of the wire
harness side connector.
ST
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
AM1 (P6-33) - Body
ground
R - Body ground
+B power supply
Always
10 to 14 V
AM2 (P6-12) - Body
ground
W - Body ground
+B power supply
Always
10 to 14 V
CDSW (P6-25) - Body
ground
L - Body ground
Key condition
No key in key slot
Below 1 Ω
CDSW (P6-25) - Body
ground
L - Body ground
Key condition
Key inserted
10 kΩ or higher
SSW1 (P6-14) - Body
ground
B - Body ground
Power switch signal
Power switch pushed
Below 1 Ω
SSW1 (P6-14) - Body
ground
B - Body ground
Power switch signal
Power switch not pushed
10 kΩ or higher
SSW2 (P6-37) - Body
ground
Y - Body ground
Power switch signal
Power switch pushed
Below 1 Ω
SSW2 (P6-37) - Body
ground
Y - Body ground
Power switch signal
Power switch not pushed
10 kΩ or higher
GND2 (P6-6) - Body
ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
(c) Reconnect the P6 ECU connector.
(d) Measure the resistance and voltage of the
connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
SOL1 (P6-3) - GND2 (P66)
P - W-B
Power switch signal
Brake pedal is not
depressed, power switch
ON (ACC)
0V
SOL1 (P6-3) - GND2 (P66)
P - W-B
Power switch signal
Brake pedal is not
depressed, power switch
ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
SOL2 (P6-20) - GND2
(P6-6)
GR - W-B
Power switch signal
Always
Below 1 Ω
ACCD (P6-11) - GND2
(P6-6)
G - W-B
ACC signal
Power switch OFF
0V
ACCD (P6-11) - GND2
(P6-6)
G - W-B
ACC signal
Power switch ON (ACC)
10 to 14 V
IG1D (P6-34) - GND2 (P66)
B - W-B
IG1 signal
Power switch ON (ACC)
0V
ST–15
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
IG1D (P6-34) - GND2 (P66)
B - W-B
IG1 signal
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
IG2D (P6-35) - GND2 (P66)
V - W-B
IG2 signal
Power switch ON (ACC)
0V
IG2D (P6-35) - GND2 (P66)
V - W-B
IG2 signal
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
STP (P6-1) - GND2 (P6-6)
L - W-B
Stop light signal
Brake pedal depressed
10 to 14 V
STP (P6-1) - GND2 (P6-6)
L - W-B
Stop light signal
Brake pedal released
0V
2.
If the result is not as specified, the ECU may have a
malfunction.
CHECK TRANSPONDER KEY ECU
T5
B076120E03
(a) Disconnect the T5 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance and voltage of the wire
harness side connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
CPUB (T5-3) - GND (T522)
L - W-B
Battery
Always
10 to 14 V
IG (T5-4) - GND (T5-22)
O - W-B
Power switch (IG)
Power switch OFF
0V
IG (T5-4) - GND (T5-22)
O - W-B
Power switch (IG)
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
ACC (T5-12) - GND (T522)
P - W-B
Power switch (ACC)
Power switch OFF
0V
ACC (T5-12) - GND (T522)
P - W-B
Power switch (ACC)
Power switch ON (ACC)
10 to 14 V
CUWS (T5-5) - GND (T522)
B - W-B
Halfway switch
No key in key slot
10 kΩ or higher
CUWS (T5-5) - GND (T522)
B - W-B
Halfway switch
Key inserted
Below 1 Ω
AGND (T5-7) - GND (T522)
P - W-B
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
GND (T5-22) - Body
ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
(c) Reconnect the T5 ECU connector.
(d) Measure the voltage of the connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
CUWS (T5-5) - GND (T522)
B - W-B
Halfway switch
No key in key slot
10 to 14 V
CUWS (T5-5) - GND (T522)
B - W-B
Halfway switch
Key inserted
Below 1 V
VC5 (T5-20) - GND (T522)
Y - W-B
Power source
No key in key slot
0V
ST
ST–16
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
VC5 (T5-20) - GND (T522)
Y - W-B
Power source
Key inserted
4.6 to 5.4 V
3.
If the result is not as specified, the ECU may have a
malfunction.
CHECK HYBRID VEHICLE CONTROL ECU
H16
H17
H15
H14
B076353E01
(a) Disconnect the H14, H15, H16 and H17 ECU
connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance and voltage of the
connectors.
ST
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
ST2 (H14-5) - GND1
(H14-1)
Y - W-B
Ignition start control signal
input
Power switch ON
(READY)
10 to 14 V
IGSW (H14-7) - GND1
(H14-1)
O - W-B
Ignition ready control
signal input
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
BATT (H15-6) - GND1
(H14-1)
Y - W-B
Battery
Always
10 to 14 V
+B1 (H16-7) - GND1
(H14-1)
L - W-B
Ignition power supply
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
+B2 (H16-6) - GND1
(H14-1)
L - W-B
Ignition power supply
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
GND1 (H14-1) - Body
ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
GND2 (H14-4) - Body
ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
4.
If the result is not as specified, the ECU may have a
malfunction.
CHECK TRANSMISSION CONTROL ECU
T4
G027319E01
(a) Disconnect the T4 ECU connector.
ST–17
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
(b) Measure the resistance and voltage of the wire
harness side connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
BATT (T4-13) - Body
ground
L - Body ground
+B power supply
Always
10 to 14 V
+B (T4-1) - Body ground
L - Body ground
Ignition power supply
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
E1 (T4-15) - Body ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
E01 (T4-3) - Body ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
E02 (T4-2) - Body ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, the ECU may have a
malfunction.
ST
ST–18
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
SG
CG
1.
DESCRIPTION
(a) Smart key system data and its Diagnosis Trouble
Codes (DTCs) can be read through the Data Link
Connector 3 (DLC3). When the system seems to be
malfunctioning, use the intelligent tester to check for
malfunctions and perform repairs.
2.
CHECK DLC3
HINT:
The vehicle uses the ISO 15765-4 communication
protocol. The terminal arrangement of the DLC3
complies with SAE J1962 and matches the ISO 15765-4
format.
SIL
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 1112 13 14 1516
BAT
A082779E96
Symbol
Terminal No.
Name
Reference terminal
Result
Condition
SIL
7
Bus "+" line
5 - Signal ground
Pulse generation
During transmission
CG
4
Chassis ground
Body ground
Below 1 Ω
Always
SG
5
Signal ground
Body ground
Below 1 Ω
Always
BAT
16
Battery positive
Body ground
11 to 14 V
Always
ST
Intelligent Tester
CAN VIM
DLC3
A082795E01
3.
If the result is not as specified, the DLC3 may have a
malfunction. Repair or replace the harness and
connector.
HINT:
Connect the cable of the intelligent tester (with CAN
VIM) to the DLC3, turn the power switch ON (IG) and
attempt to use the intelligent tester. If the display informs
that a communication error has occurred, there is a
problem either with the vehicle or with the tester.
• If communication is normal when the tester is
connected to another vehicle, inspect the DLC3 of the
original vehicle.
• If communication is still not possible when the tester
is connected to another vehicle, the problem is
probably in the tester itself. Consult the Service
Department listed in the tester's instruction manual.
INSPECT BATTERY VOLTAGE
Standard voltage:
11 to 14 V
If the voltage is below 11 V, replace the battery before
proceeding.
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
ST–19
DTC CHECK / CLEAR
Intelligent Tester
1.
CAN VIM
DLC3
A082795E01
2.
CHECK DTC
(a) Connect the intelligent tester to the Controller Area
Network Vehicle Interface Module (CAN VIM). Then
connect the CAN VIM to the DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Read the DTCs by following the directions on the
tester screen.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual for
further details.
CLEAR DTC
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Erase the DTCs by following the directions on the
tester screen.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual for
further details.
ST
ST–20
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST
1.
READ DATA LIST
HINT:
Using the intelligent tester's DATA LIST allows switch,
sensor, actuator and other item values to be read without
removing any parts. Reading the DATA LIST early in
troubleshooting is one way to save time.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Read the DATA LIST according to the display on the
tester.
Power source control ECU
ST
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
STR UNLK SW
Steering unlock switch /
ON or OFF
ON: Key is in key slot
OFF: No key is in key slot
-
READY SIG
Ready signal /
ON or OFF
ON: Power switch ON (READY)
OFF: Power switch OFF or ON
(IG) or ON (ACC)
-
VEHICLE SPD SIG
Vehicle speed signal /
ON or OFF
Stop: Vehicle is stopped
Run: Vehicle is running
-
SHIFT P SIG
Shift P signal /
ON or OFF
ON: Shift P signal ON (shift
position is P)
OFF: Shift P signal OFF (shift
position is not P)
-
ST READY MON
Starter relay monitor /
ON or OFF
ON: Starter relay signal ON
OFF: Starter relay signal OFF
-
ACC CUT SIG
Relay monitor /
ON or OFF
ON: ACC relay signal ON
OFF: ACC relay signal OFF
-
E/G COND
Engine condition /
Stop or Run
Stop: Engine is stopped
Run: Engine is not running
-
SHIFT P PULSE
Shift P signal pulse /
Unknown, Error2, Normal2,
Error1, Normal3, Error3 or
Normal1
Unknown: Other
Error2: Signal is abnormal and
shift position is P
Normal2: Signal is normal and
shift position is P
Error1: Signal is abnormal and
shift position cannot be
determined
Normal3: Signal is normal and
shift position in not P
Error3: Signal is abnormal and
shift position in not P
Normal1: Signal is normal and
shift position cannot be
determined
-
CARD H-INS SW
Halfway switch /
ON or OFF
ON: Key is half-inserted
OFF: Key is not half-inserted
-
CARD F-INS SW
Full switch /
ON or OFF
ON: Key is fully inserted
OFF: Key is not fully inserted
-
STOP LAMP SW1
Stop light switch 1 /
ON or OFF
ON: Brake pedal depressed
OFF: Brake pedal released
-
STOP LAMP SW2
Stop light switch 2 /
ON or OFF
ON: Brake pedal released
OFF: Brake pedal depressed
-
ST SW1
Start switch 1 /
ON or OFF
ON: Power switch ON (IG)
OFF: Power switch OFF
-
ST SW2
Start switch 2 /
ON or OFF
ON: Power switch ON (IG)
OFF: Power switch OFF
-
ST–21
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
RATCH CIRCUIT
Ratch circuit /
ON or OFF
ON: Power switch ON (IG)
OFF: Power switch OFF or ON
(ACC) or ON (READY)
-
IG1 RELAY MON 1
IG1 outer relay monitor /
ON or OFF
ON: Power switch ON (IG)
OFF: Power switch OFF
-
IG1 RELAY MON 2
IG1 inner relay monitor /
ON or OFF
ON: Power switch ON (IG)
OFF: Power switch OFF
-
IG2 RELAY MON 1
States of the IG2 outer relay
monitor /
ON or OFF
ON: Power switch ON (IG)
OFF: Power switch OFF
-
IG2 RELAY MON 2
IG2 Inner relay monitor /
ON or OFF
ON: Power switch ON (IG)
OFF: Power switch OFF
-
ACC RELAY MON
ACC relay monitor /
ON or OFF
ON: Power switch ON (ACC)
OFF: Power switch OFF
-
PWR COND
Power supply condition /
IG2 ON, ST ON, All OFF, IG1 ON
or ACC ON
IG2 ON: IG2 relay ON
ST ON: ST relay ON
All OFF: All relay OFF
IG1 ON: IG1 relay ON
ACC ON: ACC relay ON
-
2.
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST
HINT:
Performing the intelligent tester's ACTIVE TEST allows
relay, VSV, actuator and other items to be operated
without removing any parts. Performing the ACTIVE
TEST early in troubleshooting is one way to save time.
The DATA LIST can be displayed during the ACTIVE
TEST.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Perform the ACTIVE TEST according to the display
on the tester.
Power source control ECU
Item
Test Details
Diagnostic Note
KEY LOCK
Key lock (turn power switch OFF during test;
turn power switch ON (IG)) ON / OFF
-
LIGHTING IND
Indicator for lighting ON / OFF
-
IND CONDITION
Indicator Green / Red / No Sig
-
ST
ST–22
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
1.
DTC CHECK
If a malfunction code is displayed during the DTC check,
check the suspected area listed for that code in the table
below, and proceed to the appropriate page.
Smart key system
ST
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
See page
B2271
Ignition Hold Monitor Malfunction
- Power source control ECU
- AM1 fuse
- AM2 fuse
- Wire harness
ST-20
B2272
Ignition 1 Monitor Malfunction
- Power source control ECU
- IG1 relay
- Wire harness
ST-22
B2273
Ignition 2 Monitor Malfunction
- Power source control ECU
- Wire harness
ST-26
B2274
ACC Monitor Malfunction
- Power source control ECU
- ACC relay
- Wire harness
ST-28
B2275
STSW Monitor Malfunction
- Power source control ECU
- Wire harness
ST-30
B2277
Detecting Vehicle Submersion
- Power source control ECU
ST-32
B2278
Engine Switch Circuit Malfunction
- Power source control ECU
- Power switch
- Wire harness
ST-33
B2281
"P" Signal Malfunction
- Power source control ECU
- Transmission control ECU
- Wire Harness
ST-36
B2282
Vehicle Speed Signal Malfunction
- Power source control ECU
- Combination meter
- Wire Harness
ST-38
B2284
Brake Signal Malfunction
- Power source control ECU
- Stop light switch
- Wire Harness
ST-40
B2286
Ready Signal Malfunction
- Power source control ECU
- Hybrid vehicle control ECU
- Wire harness
ST-43
B2287
LIN Communication Master
Malfunction
- Power source control ECU
- Transponder key ECU
- Wire harness
ST-45
B2289
Key Collation Waiting Time Over
- Power source control ECU
- Engine immobiliser system
- Wire harness
ST-45
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
ST–23
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
CHECK POWER SWITCH MODE CHANGE FUNCTION
(a) Check the function of the power switch.
(1) Check that power switch mode changes in
accordance with the conditions of the shift
position and brake pedal.
HINT:
For the vehicles with the smart key system (for
door lock), the power switch functions not only
when the key is inserted into the key slot but
also when the driver carries the key.
Shift Position
Brake Pedal
Change of power switch mode (Arrow "→"
means 1 press of power switch)
P
Released
OFF → ON (ACC) → ON (IG) → OFF
(Repeated)
P
Depressed
OFF → Hybrid system starts
P
Depressed
ON (ACC) → Hybrid system starts
P
Depressed
ON (IG) → Hybrid system starts
P
Depressed
Hybrid system operating → OFF
P
Released
Hybrid system operating → OFF
Any position other than P
Released
ON (ACC) → ON (IG)
Any position other than P
Depressed
ON (ACC) → ON (IG)
Any position other than P
Released
ON (IG) → OFF after shift position switched to
P (shift-linked OFF function)
Any position other than P
Released
Hybrid system operating → OFF after shift
position switched to P (auto P control
function)
Any position other than P
Depressed
Hybrid system operating → OFF after shift
position switched to P (auto P control
function)
(b) Check if power switch mode changes without
pressing the power switch.
(1) With power switch mode ON (ACC) and the
shift position in P, pull out the key. Check that
power switch mode changes from ON (ACC) to
OFF automatically.
(2) With power switch mode ON (ACC) and the
shift position in P, wait for at least 1 hour. Check
that power switch mode changes from ON
(ACC) to OFF automatically.
2.
CHECK KEY INTERLOCK FUNCTION
(a) Insert the key into key slot, and change power
switch modes and shift position according to the
table below. Check whether or not the key is locked
in the key slot.
Power Switch Mode
Shift Position
Key Status
OFF
P
Not locked in
OFF
Any position except P
-
ON (ACC)
P
Not locked in
ON (ACC)
Any position except P
Locked in
ON (IG)
P
Locked in
ON (IG)
Any position except P
Locked in
ST
ST–24
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
Power Switch Mode
Shift Position
Key Status
READY (hybrid system ON)
P
Locked in
READY (hybrid system ON)
Any position except P
Locked in
3.
Indicator
Power Switch
B080592E01
ST
CHECK INDICATOR CONDITION
(a) Check the power indicator on the power switch.
(1) Check that the power indicator illuminates and
changes its color according to the table below.
Power Switch Mode
Indicator Status
OFF
OFF
ON (ACC)
Green illumination
ON (IG)
Amber illumination
Hybrid System ON
OFF
Push button start system malfunctioning
Flashes continuously in amber
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
DTC
B2271
ST–25
Ignition Hold Monitor Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
This DTC is output when the IG output circuits inside the power source control ECU are open or short.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B2271
Hold circuit, IG1 relay actuation circuit or IG2
relay actuation circuit inside power source
control ECU is open or short
•
•
•
•
Power source control ECU
AM1 fuse
AM2 fuse
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
Power Source Control ECU
AM1
from
Battery
AM1
ST
AM2
from
Battery
AM2
B128115E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Delete the DTC (see page ST-15).
(b) Check for DTCs again.
OK:
No DTC is output.
OK
END
NG
2
INSPECT FUSE (AM1, AM2)
(a) Remove the AM1 fuse from the driver side junction
block.
ST–26
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
(b) Remove the AM2 fuse from the engine room junction
block.
(c) Measure the resistance of the fuses.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE FUSE
OK
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU - BATTERY)
(a) Disconnect the P6 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
Power Source Control ECU
P6
AM2
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
P6-33 (AM1) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
P6-12 (AM2) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
NG
AM1
B079748E03
OK
ST
REPLACE POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
ST–27
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
DTC
B2272
Ignition 1 Monitor Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
This DTC is output when a malfunction is occurring in the IG output circuit, which is from the IG1 relay
actuation circuit inside the power source control ECU to the IG1 relay.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B2272
IG1 relay actuation circuit inside power
source control ECU or other related circuit is
malfunctioning
•
•
•
Power source control ECU
IG1 relay
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
Power Source Control ECU
Driver Side Junction Block
to
Center Connector
IG1
from
Battery
GAUGE
IG1D
ST
B135511E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF DATA LIST (IG1 RELAY)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and press the intelligent
tester main switch ON.
(c) Select the items below in the DATA LIST and read the
displays on the intelligent tester.
Power source control ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
IG1 RELAY MON 1
IG1 outer relay monitor /
ON or OFF
ON: Power switch ON (IG)
OFF: Power switch OFF
-
OK:
ON (power switch ON (IG)) appears on the screen.
ST–28
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
OK
REPLACE POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU
NG
2
INSPECT IG1 RELAY
(a) Remove the IG1 relay from the driver side junction block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the relay.
Standard resistance
B112776E02
OK
ST
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to
terminals 1 and 2)
NG
REPLACE IG1 RELAY
ST–29
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK - ECU AND BODY GROUND)
Wire Harness Side
Power Source Control ECU
P6
(a) Disconnect the 1J and 1E driver side junction block
connectors.
(b) Disconnect the P6 ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
IG1D
Driver Side Junction Block
Specified Condition
1J-3 - P6-34 (IG1D)
Below 1 Ω
1J-3 or P6-34 (IG1D) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
1E-17 - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
1E
ST
Driver Side Junction Block
1J
㪞
B128121E01
OK
ST–30
4
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
CHECK DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
(a) Remove the IG1 relay from the driver side junction block.
(b) Disconnect the 1J and 1E driver side junction block
connectors.
(c) Measure the resistance of the driver side junction block.
Standard resistance
Driver Side Junction Block
1E
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1J-3 - Driver side junction block IG1
relay terminal 2
Below 1 Ω
1E-17 - Driver side junction block IG1
relay terminal 1
Below 1 Ω
NG
Driver Side Junction Block
1J
IG1 Relay
ST
B135432E01
OK
REPLACE POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
ASSEMBLY
ST–31
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
DTC
B2273
Ignition 2 Monitor Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
This DTC is output when a malfunction is occurring in the IG output circuit, which is from the IG2 relay
actuation circuit inside the power source control ECU to the IG2 relay.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B2273
IG2 relay actuation circuit inside power
source control ECU or other related circuit is
malfunctioning
•
•
Power source control ECU
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
Engine Room Junction Block
to
Battery ECU
Power Source Control ECU
from
Battery
IG2
AM2
IG2D
ST
B135510E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF DATA LIST (IG2 RELAY)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and press the intelligent
tester main switch ON.
(c) Read the DATA LIST according to the displays on the
tester.
Power source control ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
IG2 RELAY MON 2
IG2 inner relay monitor /
ON or OFF
ON: Power switch ON (IG)
OFF: Power switch OFF
-
OK:
ON (power switch ON (IG)) appears on the screen.
ST–32
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
OK
REPLACE POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU
NG
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ENGINE ROOM JUNCTION BLOCK - ECU AND BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the 3I junction block connector.
(b) Disconnect the P6 ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Engine Room Junction Block
3I
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3I-2 - P6-35 (IG2D)
Below 1 Ω
3I-3 - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
Power Source Control ECU
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
P6
IG2D
ST
B080046E01
OK
3
CHECK ENGINE ROOM RELAY BLOCK
(a) Disconnect the 3I and 3K junction block connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance of the junction block connectors.
Standard resistance
Engine Room Junction Block
3I
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
3K-1 - 3I-4
When battery voltage is
not applied to terminals
3I-2 and 3I-3
10 kΩ or higher
3K-1 - 3I-4
When battery voltage is
applied to terminals 3I-2
and 3I-3
Below 1 Ω
3K
B080053E01
NG
OK
REPLACE POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU
REPLACE ENGINE ROOM RELAY BLOCK
ST–33
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
DTC
B2274
ACC Monitor Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
This DTC is output when a malfunction is occurring in the ACC output circuit, which is from the ACC relay
actuation circuit inside the power source control ECU to the ACC relay.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B2274
ACC relay actuation circuit inside power
source control ECU or other related circuit is
malfunctioning
•
•
•
Power source control ECU
ACC relay
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
Power Source Control ECU
to
Transponder Key ECU
from
Battery
ACC
ACCD
ST
B128110E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF DATA LIST (ACC RELAY)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and press the intelligent
tester main switch ON.
(c) Read the DATA LIST according to the displays on the
tester.
Power source control ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
ACC RELAY MON
ACC relay monitor /
ON or OFF
ON: Power switch ON (ACC)
OFF: Power switch OFF
-
OK:
ON (power switch ON (ACC)) appears on the
screen.
ST–34
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
OK
REPLACE POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU
NG
2
INSPECT ACC RELAY
(a) Remove the ACC relay.
(b) Measure the resistance of the relay.
Standard resistance
2
5
3
1
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
5
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to
terminals 1 and 2)
2
1
3
B060778E74
NG
REPLACE ACC RELAY
OK
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ACC RELAY - POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU AND BODY
GROUND)
(a) Remove the ACC relay.
(b) Disconnect the P6 connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
ST
ACC Relay
A12
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A12-1 - P6-11 (ACCD)
Below 1 Ω
A12-2 - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
A12-1 or P6-11 (ACCD) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
Power Source Control ECU
P6
ACCD
)
B128118E01
OK
REPLACE POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
ST–35
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
DTC
B2275
STSW Monitor Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
This DTC is output when the ST output circuits inside the power source control ECU is open or short.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B2275
ST output circuit inside power source control
ECU or other related circuit is malfunctioning
•
•
•
Power source control ECU
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
Power Source Control ECU
Hybrid Vehicle Control ECU
STSW
ST2
ST
B128114E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Delete the DTC (see page ST-15).
(b) Check for DTCs again.
OK:
No DTC is output.
OK
NG
END
ST–36
2
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU - HYBRID VEHICLE
CONTROL ECU)
Wire Harness Side
Power Source Control ECU
(a) Disconnect the P6 and H14 ECU connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
P6
Specified Condition
P6-39 (STSW) - H14-5 (ST2)
Below 1 Ω
P6-39 (STSW) or H14-5 (ST2) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
STSW
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
Hybrid Vehicle Control ECU
ST2
H14
)
ST
B128123E01
OK
3
CHECK OPERATION OF POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU
(a) After replacing the power source control ECU with a
normally functioning ECU, check that the hybrid control
system can start normally.
OK:
Hybrid control system can start normally.
NG
GO TO HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
OK
NORMAL (POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU DEFECTIVE)
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
DTC
B2277
ST–37
Detecting Vehicle Submersion
DESCRIPTION
This DTC is output when the submersion circuit monitor inside the power source control ECU detects that
the vehicle is submerged in water.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B2277
Submersion circuit monitor inside power
source control ECU detects that vehicle is
submerged in water
Power source control ECU
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Delete the DTC (see page ST-15).
(b) Check for DTCs again.
OK:
No DTC is output.
NG
REPLACE POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU
OK
END
ST
ST–38
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
DTC
B2278
Engine Switch Circuit Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
This DTC is output when 1) a malfunction is detected between the power source control ECU and the
power switch; or 2) either of the switches inside the power switch is malfunctioning.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B2278
Communication is abnormal between power
source control ECU and power switch; or
power switch is defective
•
•
•
Power source control ECU
Power switch
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
Power Source Control ECU
Power Switch
SS2
ST
SSW2
SS1
SSW1
GND
B128111E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF DATA LIST (START SWITCH 1 and 2)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and press the intelligent
tester main switch ON.
ST–39
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
(c) Read the DATA LIST according to the displays on the
tester.
Power source control ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
ST SW1
Start Switch 1 /
ON or OFF
ON: Power switch ON (IG)
OFF: Power switch OFF
-
ST SW2
Start Switch 2 /
ON or OFF
ON: Power switch ON (IG)
OFF: Power switch OFF
-
OK:
ON (power switches 1 and 2 are ON (IG)) appears
on the screen
OK
REPLACE POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU
NG
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (POWER SWITCH - POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU AND
BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the P11 power switch connector.
(b) Disconnect the P6 ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Power Source Control ECU
SSW1
P6
SSW2
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
P11-5 (SS1) - P6-14 (SSW1)
Below 1 Ω
P11-7 (SS2) - P6-37 (SSW2)
Below 1 Ω
P11-6 - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
P11-5 (SS2) or P6-14 (SSW1) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
P11-7 (SS2) or P6-37 (SSW2) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
Power Switch
NG
P11
SS1
)
SS2
B128120E01
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
ST
ST–40
3
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
INSPECT POWER SWITCH
(a) Remove the power switch.
(b) Measure the resistance of the switch.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
7 (SS2) - 6 (GND)
Pushed
Below 1 Ω
5 (SS1) - 6 (GND)
Pushed
Below 1 Ω
7 (SS2) - 6 (GND)
Released
10 kΩ or higher
5 (SS1) - 6 (GND)
Released
10 kΩ or higher
B080048E03
NG
OK
REPLACE POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU
ST
REPLACE POWER SWITCH
ST–41
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
DTC
B2281
"P" Signal Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The power source control ECU and the transmission control ECU are connected by a cable and the
BEAN. If the cable information and BEAN information are inconsistent, this DTC will be output.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B2281
Cable and BEAN between power source
control ECU and transmission control ECU
are inconsistent
•
•
•
Power source control ECU
Transmission control ECU
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
Transmission Control ECU
Power Source Control ECU
ST
P
PPOS
B128114E02
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF DATA LIST (SHIFT P SIGNAL)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and press the intelligent
tester main switch ON.
(c) Read the DATA LIST according to the displays on the
tester.
Power source control ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
SHIFT P SIG
Shift P Signal /
ON or OFF
ON: Shift P signal ON (Shift
position is P)
OFF: Shift P signal OFF (Shift
position is not P)
-
ST–42
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
OK:
"ON" (P signal is ON) appears on the screen.
OK
REPLACE POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU
NG
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU - TRANSMISSION CONTROL
ECU)
Wire Harness Side
Power Source Control ECU
P
P6
(a) Disconnect the P6 and T4 ECU connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
P6-5 (P) - T4-8 (PPOS)
Below 1 Ω
P6-5 (P) or T4-8 (PPOS) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
Transmission Control ECU
ST
T4
PPOS
)
B128122E01
OK
3
CHECK OPERATION OF POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU
(a) After replacing the power source control ECU with a
normally functioning ECU, check that the hybrid control
system can start normally.
OK:
Hybrid control system can start normally.
NG
GO TO SHIFT CONTROL SYSTEM
OK
NORMAL (POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU DEFECTIVE)
ST–43
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
DTC
B2282
Vehicle Speed Signal Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The power source control ECU and the combination meter are connected by a cable and the BEAN. This
DTC is output when: 1) the cable information and BEAN information are inconsistent; and 2) a malfunction
is detected between the vehicle speed sensor and combination meter.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B2282
Both conditions below are met:
• Cable for BEAN information between
power source control ECU and
combination meter are inconsistent
• Malfunction is detected between vehicle
speed sensor and combination meter
•
•
•
Power source control ECU
Combination meter
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
Combination Meter
Power Source Control ECU
ST
Joining Connector
SPD
IG2
B128130E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF DATA LIST (VEHICLE SPEED SIGNAL)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and press the intelligent
tester main switch ON.
(c) Read the DATA LIST according to the displays on the
tester.
Power source control ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
VEHICLE SPD SIG
Vehicle speed signal /
Stop or Run
Stop: Vehicle is stopped
Run: Vehicle is running
-
ST–44
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
OK:
STOP (vehicle is stopped) appears on the screen.
OK
REPLACE POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU
NG
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU - IG2 JOINING CONNECTOR)
(a) Disconnect the P6 connector.
(b) Disconnect the IG2 connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Joining Connector
IG2
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
P6-19 (SPD) - IG2-16
Below 1 Ω
P6-19 (SPD) or IG2-16 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
Power Source Control ECU
P6
ST
SPD
B081038E01
OK
3
CHECK OPERATION OF POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU
(a) After replacing the power source control ECU with a
normally functioning ECU, check that the hybrid control
system can start normally.
OK:
Hybrid control system can start normally.
NG
GO TO METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
OK
NORMAL (POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU DEFECTIVE)
ST–45
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
DTC
B2284
Brake Signal Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
This DTC is output when: 1) the brake signal circuit between the power source control ECU and the stop
light switch is malfunctioning, and 2) the BEAN information is inconsistent.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B2284
Communication or communication line is
abnormal between power source control ECU
and stop light switch
•
•
•
Power source control ECU
Stop light switch
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
Power Source Control ECU
Stop Light Switch
to
Hybrid Vehicle
Control ECU
from
Battery
ST
STOP
STP
from
Battery
B128109E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF DATA LIST (STOP LIGHT SWITCH)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and press the intelligent
tester main switch ON.
ST–46
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
(c) Read the DATA LIST according to the displays on the
tester.
Power source control ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
STOP LAMP SW1
Stop light switch 1 /
ON or OFF
ON: Brake pedal depressed
OFF: Brake pedal released
-
OK:
ON (brake pedal depressed) appears on the
screen.
OK
REPLACE POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU
NG
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (STOP LIGHT SWITCH - POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU AND
BATTERY)
(a) Disconnect the S16 switch connector.
(b) Disconnect the P6 ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance and voltage of the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Stop Light Switch
S16
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S16-1 - P6-1 (STP)
Below 1 Ω
Standard voltage
ST
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S16-2 - Body ground
10 to 14 V
Power Source Control ECU
NG
STP
P6
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
B080047E01
OK
3
INSPECT STOP LIGHT SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the stop light switch.
ST–47
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
S16
Not Pushed
2
1
4
3
Pushed
E130045E01
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
Switch pin not pushed
Below 1 Ω
3-4
Switch pin not pushed
10 kΩ or higher
1-2
Switch pin pushed
10 kΩ or higher
3-4
Switch pin pushed
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE STOP LIGHT SWITCH ASSEMBLY
OK
REPLACE POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU
ST
ST–48
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
DTC
B2286
Ready Signal Malfunction
DESCRIPTION
The power source control ECU and the hybrid vehicle control ECU are connected by a cable and the
BEAN. If the cable information and BEAN information are inconsistent, this DTC will be output.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B2286
Cable and BEAN information between power
source control ECU and hybrid vehicle control
ECU are inconsistent
•
•
•
Power source control ECU
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
Power Source Control ECU
Hybrid Vehicle Control ECU
ST
RDY
RDY
B128114E04
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF DATA LIST (READY SIGNAL)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and press the intelligent
tester main switch ON.
(c) Read the DATA LIST according to the displays on the
tester.
Power source control ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
READY SIG
Ready signal /
ON or OFF
ON: Power switch ON (READY)
OFF: Power switch OFF or ON
(IG) or ON (ACC)
-
ST–49
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
OK:
ON (power switch is ON (READY)) appears on the
screen.
OK
REPLACE POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU
NG
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU - HYBRID VEHICLE
CONTROL ECU)
Wire Harness Side
Power Source Control ECU
P6
RDY
(a) Disconnect the P6 and H14 ECU connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
P6-22 (RDY) - H14-28 (RDY)
Below 1 Ω
P6-22 (RDY) or H14-28 (RDY) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
Hybrid Vehicle Control ECU
ST
H14
RDY
)
B128123E02
OK
3
CHECK OPERATION OF POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU
(a) After replacing the power source control ECU with a
normally functioning ECU, check that the hybrid vehicle
control system can start normally.
OK:
Hybrid vehicle control system can start normally.
NG
GO TO HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
OK
NORMAL (POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU DEFECTIVE)
ST–50
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
DTC
B2287
LIN Communication Master Malfunction
DTC
B2289
Key Collation Waiting Time Over
DESCRIPTION
This DTC is output when: 1) any other DTC is set in the power source control ECU; or 2) the wire harness
between the power source control ECU and the transponder key ECU is open or short.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
B2287
Communication or communication line is
abnormal between power source control ECU
and transponder key ECU
•
•
•
Power source control ECU
Transponder key ECU
Wire harness
B2289
Either condition below is met:
• Cable and BEAN are abnormal between
power source control ECU and
immobiliser system
• Immobiliser system is malfunctioning
•
•
•
Power source control ECU
Engine immobiliser system
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
Transponder Key ECU
Power Source Control ECU
ST
LIN1
LIN1
B128114E05
ST–51
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU - TRANSPONDER KEY ECU)
Wire Harness Side
Power Source Control ECU
P6
LIN1
(a) Disconnect the P6 and T5 ECU connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
P6-30 (LIN1) - T5-14 (LIN1)
Below 1 Ω
P6-30 (LIN1) or T5-14 (LIN1) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
Transponder Key ECU
T5
LIN1
)
B128122E02
ST
OK
2
CHECK OPERATION OF POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU
(a) After replacing power source control ECU with a
normally functioning ECU, check that the hybrid control
system can start normally.
Result
Result
Proceed to
Hybrid system can start normally
A
Hybrid system cannot start (w/ smart key system (for door lock))
B
Hybrid system cannot start (w/o smart key system (for door lock))
C
B
GO TO ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/
SMART KEY SYSTEM)
C
GO TO ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o
SMART KEY SYSTEM)
A
NORMAL (POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU DEFECTIVE)
ST–52
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
Power Mode does not Change to ON (IG and ACC)
DESCRIPTION
When the key is inserted into the key slot and the power switch is pressed, signals are input to the power
source control ECU. Selection of the power mode, which cycles between OFF, ON (ACC) and ON (IG), is
performed by pressing and releasing the power switch until the desired power mode is selected (the
power modes cycle in the order shown above).
ST
ST–53
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Power Source Control ECU
from
Battery
AM1
from
Battery
AM2
AM1
AM2
Power Switch
SS2
SSW2
SS1
SSW1
GND
ST
GND2
COM
Key Slot
KSW2
CDSW
)
B121307E01
ST–54
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT FUSE (AM1, AM2)
(a) Remove the AM1 fuse from the driver side junction
block.
(b) Remove the AM2 fuse from the engine room junction
block.
(c) Measure the resistance of the fuses.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE FUSE
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU - BATTERY AND BODY
GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the P6 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance and voltage of the wire harness
side connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Power Source Control ECU
GND2
P6
AM2
ST
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
P6-6 (GND2) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
Standard voltage
AM1
B079748E04
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
P6-33 (AM1) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
P6-12 (AM2) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
3
CHECK FOR DTC (POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU)
(a) Check for DTCs of the power source control ECU.
OK:
DTCs of the power source control ECU are not
output.
NG
OK
GO TO DTC CHART
ST–55
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
4
CHECK FOR DTC (TRANSPONDER KEY ECU)
(a) Check for DTCs of the transponder key ECU.
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTCs of transponder key ECU are not output
A
DTCs of transponder key ECU are output (w/ smart key system (for
door lock))
B
DTCs of transponder key ECU are output (w/o smart key system (for
door lock))
C
B
GO TO ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/
SMART KEY SYSTEM)
C
GO TO ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o
SMART KEY SYSTEM)
A
5
READ VALUE OF DATA LIST (STEERING UNLOCK SWITCH)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Press the intelligent tester main switch ON.
(c) Read the DATA LIST according to the displays on the
tester.
Power source control ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
STR UNLK SW
Steering unlock switch /
ON or OFF
ON: Key is in key slot
OFF: No key is in key slot
-
OK:
ON (key is in key slot) appears on the screen.
OK
NG
Go to step 8
ST
ST–56
6
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (KEY SLOT - POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU AND BODY
GROUND)
Wire Harness Side
Power Source Control ECU
P6
CDSW
(a) Disconnect the K2 key slot connector.
(b) Disconnect the P6 ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
K2-3 (KSW2) - P6-25 (CDSW)
Below 1 Ω
K2-2 (COM) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
K2-3 (KSW2) or P6-25 (CDSW) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
Key Slot
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
K2
COM
KSW2
)
ST
B128119E01
OK
7
INSPECT KEY SLOT
(a) Remove the key slot.
(b) Measure the resistance of the key slot.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
K2-3 (KSW2) - K2-2
(COM)
Key is in key slot
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPLACE KEY SLOT
B080048E04
OK
REPLACE POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU
8
READ VALUE OF DATA LIST (START SWITCH 1 and 2)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Press the intelligent tester main switch ON.
ST–57
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
(c) Read the DATA LIST according to the displays on the
tester.
Power source control ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
ST SW1
Start switch 1 /
ON or OFF
ON: Power switch ON (IG) (push
power switch)
OFF: Power switch OFF (release
power switch)
-
ST SW2
Start switch 2 /
ON or OFF
ON: Power switch ON (IG) (push
power switch)
OFF: Power switch OFF (release
power switch)
-
OK:
"ON" (power switch ON (IG)) appears on the
screen.
OK
REPLACE POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU
NG
9
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (POWER SWITCH - POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU AND
BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the P11 power switch connector.
(b) Disconnect the P6 ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Wire Harness Side
Power Source Control ECU
SSW1
P6
SSW2
P11
SS1
GND
SS2
B128120E02
OK
Specified Condition
5 (SS1) - 14 (SSW1)
Below 1 Ω
7 (SS2) - 37 (SSW2)
Below 1 Ω
6 (GND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
5 (SS1) or 14 (SSW1) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
7 (SS2) or 37 (SSW2) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
Power Switch
)
Tester Connection
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
ST
ST–58
10
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
INSPECT POWER SWITCH
(a) Remove the power switch.
(b) Measure the resistance of the switch.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
7 (SS2) - 6 (GND)
Pushed
Below 1 Ω
5 (SS1) - 6 (GND)
Pushed
Below 1 Ω
7 (SS2) - 6 (GND)
Released
10 kΩ or higher
5 (SS1) - -6 (GND)
Released
10 kΩ or higher
B080048E02
NG
OK
REPLACE POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU
ST
REPLACE POWER SWITCH
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
ST–59
Power Mode does not Change to ON (IG)
DESCRIPTION
When the key is inserted into the key slot and the power switch is pressed, signals are input to the power
source control ECU. Selection of the power mode, which cycles between OFF, ON (ACC) and ON (IG), is
performed by pressing and releasing the power switch until the desired power mode is selected (the
power modes cycle in the order shown above).
ST
ST–60
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Power Source Control ECU
IG1D
AM1
from
Battery
AM1
IG1
Driver Side Junction Block
GAUGE
ST
to
Combination Meter
AM2
from
Battery
AM2
Engine Room
Junction Block
IG2D
IG2
Driver Side Junction Block
GND2
to
Battery ECU
)
IGN
B135509E01
ST–61
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT FUSE (AM1, AM2)
(a) Remove the AM1 fuse from the driver side junction
block.
(b) Remove the AM2 fuse from the engine room junction
block.
(c) Measure the resistance of the fuses.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE FUSE
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU - BATTERY AND BODY
GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the P6 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance and voltage of the wire harness
side connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Power Source Control ECU
GND2
P6
AM2
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
P6-6 (GND2) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
ST
Standard voltage
AM1
Tester Connection
B079748E04
Specified Condition
P6-33 (AM1) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
P6-12 (AM2) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
3
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Check for DTCs of the power source control ECU.
OK:
DTCs of the power source control ECU are not
output.
NG
OK
GO TO DTC CHART
ST–62
4
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
INSPECT IG1 RELAY
(a) Remove the IG1 relay from the driver side junction block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the relay.
Standard resistance
B112776E02
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to
terminals 1 and 2)
NG
REPLACE IG1 RELAY
OK
5
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK - ECU AND BODY GROUND)
Wire Harness Side
Power Source Control ECU
P6
ST
IG1D
1E
Driver Side Junction Block
1J
B128121E01
OK
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1J-3 - P6-34 (IG1D)
Below 1 Ω
1E-17 - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
1J-3 or P6-34 (IG1D) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
Driver Side Junction Block
㪞
(a) Disconnect the 1J and 1E junction block connectors.
(b) Disconnect the P6 ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
ST–63
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
6
INSPECT DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
(a) Disconnect the 1J and 1E junction block connectors.
(b) Remove the IG1 relay from the driver side junction block.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Driver Side Junction Block
1E
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1J-3 - Driver side junction block IG1
relay terminal 2
Below 1 Ω
1E-17 - Driver side junction block IG1
relay terminal 1
Below 1 Ω
NG
Driver Side Junction Block
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
ASSEMBLY
1J
IG1 Relay
ST
B135432E01
OK
ST–64
7
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ENGINE ROOM JUNCTION BLOCK - ECU AND BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the 3I junction block connector.
(b) Disconnect the P6 ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Engine Room Junction Block
3I
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3I-2 - P6-35 (IG2D)
Below 1 Ω
3I-3 - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
3I-2 or P6-35 (IG2D) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
Power Source Control ECU
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
P6
IG2D
B080046E01
OK
ST
8
CHECK POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU (IG1D, IG2D VOLTAGE)
(a) Measure the voltage of the connector.
Standard voltage
Power Source Control ECU
IG2D
IG1D
B135413E01
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
P6-34 (IG1D) - Body
ground
Power switch ON (ACC)
Below 1 V
P6-35 (IG2D) - Body
ground
Power switch ON (ACC)
Below 1 V
P6-34 (IG1D) - Body
ground
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
P6-35 (IG2D) - Body
ground
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
NG
OK
REPLACE POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU
ST–65
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
9
CHECK ENGINE ROOM RELAY BLOCK
(a) Measure the voltage of the connector.
Standard voltage
Engine Room Junction Block
3I
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
3I-4 - Body ground
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
NG
REPLACE ENGINE ROOM RELAY BLOCK
B135414E01
OK
10
CHECK OPERATION OF POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU
(a) After replacing the power source control ECU with a
normally functioning ECU, check that the power switch
can be set to ON (IG).
Result
Result
Proceed to
Power switch can be set to ON (IG)
A
Power switch cannot be set to ON (IG) (w/ smart key system (for door
lock))
B
Power switch cannot be set to ON (IG) (w/o smart key system (for
door lock))
C
ST
B
GO TO ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/
SMART KEY SYSTEM)
C
GO TO ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o
SMART KEY SYSTEM)
A
NORMAL (POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU DEFECTIVE)
ST–66
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
Power Mode does not Change to ON (ACC)
DESCRIPTION
When the key is inserted into the key slot and the power switch is pressed, signals are input to the power
source control ECU. Selection of the power mode, which cycles between OFF, ON (ACC) and ON (IG), is
performed by pressing and releasing the power switch until the desired power mode is selected (the
power modes cycle in the order shown above).
ST
ST–67
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Power Source Control ECU
AM2
from
Battery
AM2
ACC
ACCD
ACC-B
ST
ACC
AM1
AM1
to
Transponder
Key ECU
)
from
Battery
GND2
B121305E01
ST–68
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT FUSE (AM1, AM2)
(a) Remove the AM1 fuse from the driver side junction
block.
(b) Remove the AM2 fuse from the engine room junction
block.
(c) Measure the resistance of the fuses.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE FUSE
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU - BATTERY AND BODY
GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the P6 ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance and voltage of the wire harness
side connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Power Source Control ECU
GND2
P6
AM2
ST
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
P6-6 (GND2) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
Standard voltage
AM1
B079748E04
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
P6-33 (AM1) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
P6-12 (AM2) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
3
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Check for DTCs of the power source control ECU.
OK:
DTCs of the power source control ECU are not
output.
NG
OK
GO TO DTC CHART
ST–69
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
4
INSPECT ACC RELAY
(a) Remove the ACC relay.
(b) Measure the resistance of the relay.
Standard resistance
2
5
3
1
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
5
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω
(when battery voltage is applied to
terminals 1 and 2)
2
1
3
B060778E74
NG
REPLACE ACC RELAY
OK
5
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ACC RELAY - POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU AND BODY
GROUND)
(a) Remove the ACC relay.
(b) Disconnect the P6 ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
ACC Relay
A12
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
A12-1 - P6-11 (ACCD)
Below 1 Ω
A12-2 - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
A12-1 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
Power Source Control ECU
P6
ACCD
)
B128118E02
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
ST
ST–70
6
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
CHECK POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU (ACCD VOLTAGE)
(a) Measure the voltage of the connector.
Standard voltage
Power Source Control ECU
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
P6-11 (ACCD) - Body
ground
Power switch ON (ACC)
10 to 14 V
P6-11 (ACCD) - Body
ground
Power switch OFF
Below 1 V
NG
ACCD
REPLACE POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU
B135413E02
OK
7
CHECK OPERATION OF POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU
(a) After replacing the power source control ECU with a
normally functioning ECU, check that the power switch
can be set to ON (ACC).
Result
ST
Result
Proceed to
Power switch can be set to ON (ACC)
A
Power switch cannot be set to ON (ACC) (w/ smart key system (for
door lock))
B
Power switch cannot be set to ON (ACC) (w/o smart key system (for
door lock))
C
B
GO TO ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/
SMART KEY SYSTEM)
C
GO TO ENGINE IMMOBILISER SYSTEM (w/o
SMART KEY SYSTEM)
A
NORMAL (POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU DEFECTIVE)
ST–71
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
Power Mode does not Change to ON (Ready)
DESCRIPTION
When the key is inserted into the key slot and the power switch is pressed, signals are input to the power
source control ECU. Selection of the power mode, which cycles between OFF, ON (ACC) and ON (IG), is
performed by pressing and releasing the power switch until the desired power mode is selected (the
power modes cycle in the order shown above). When the shift position is P, the brake pedal is depressed
and held and the power switch is pressed, the power switch mode changes to ON (READY), signifying
that the hybrid system has started operating.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Power Source Control ECU
Stop Light Switch
to
Hybrid Vehicle
Control ECU
from
Battery
ST
STOP
STP
from
Battery
B128109E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
BASIC INSPECTION
(a) Check that the P position switch is ON.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (READY) and check that the
hybrid control system starts normally. Make sure the
brake pedal is depressed at this time.
OK:
Hybrid control system starts normally (power
switch can be set to ON (READY)).
OK
END
ST–72
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
NG
2
CHECK OPERATION OF POWER SWITCH
(a) Check that the power mode can be changed by pushing
the power switch.
HINT:
With the power switch OFF, do not depress the brake
pedal and push the power switch repeatedly. The power
mode should change as follows:
ON (ACC), ON (IG), OFF.
With the power switch OFF, depress the brake pedal and
push the power switch repeatedly. The power mode
should change as follows:
ON (READY), OFF.
OK:
Power switch operates normally.
NG
OTHER PROBLEM
OK
3
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Check for DTCs of the power source control ECU.
OK:
DTCs of the power source control ECU are not
output
ST
NG
GO TO DTC CHART
OK
4
READ VALUE OF DATA LIST (STOP LIGHT SWITCH 1 and 2)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and push the intelligent
tester main switch ON.
(c) Read the DATA LIST according to the display on the
tester.
Power source control ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
STOP LAMP SW1
Stop light switch 1 /
ON or OFF
ON: Brake pedal depressed
OFF: Brake pedal released
-
STOP LAMP SW2
Stop light switch 2 /
ON or OFF
ON: Brake pedal depressed
OFF: Brake pedal released
-
OK:
ON (stop light switch ON) appears on the screen.
OK
Go to step 8
ST–73
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
NG
5
CHECK POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU (STP VOLTAGE)
(a) Measure the voltage when the brake pedal is operated.
Standard voltage
Power Source Control ECU
P6
STP
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
P6-1 (STP) - Body
ground
Brake pedal released
10 to 14 V
P6-1 (STP) - Body
ground
Brake pedal depressed
Below 1 V
OK
REPLACE POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU
B135413E03
NG
6
INSPECT STOP LIGHT SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the stop light switch.
S16
Not Pushed
2
1
4
3
ST
Pushed
E130045E01
(b) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in the
table below.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
Switch pin not pushed
Below 1 Ω
3-4
Switch pin not pushed
10 kΩ or higher
1-2
Switch pin pushed
10 kΩ or higher
3-4
Switch pin pushed
Below 1 Ω
NG
OK
REPLACE STOP LIGHT SWITCH ASSEMBLY
ST–74
7
1NZ-FXE STARTING – SMART KEY SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (STOP LIGHT SWITCH - POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU AND
BATTERY)
(a) Disconnect the S16 switch connector.
(b) Disconnect the P6 ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance and voltage of the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Stop Light Switch
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S16-1 - P6-1 (STP)
Below 1 Ω
S16
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
S16-2 - Body ground
10 to 14 V
Power Source Control ECU
NG
STP
P6
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
B080047E01
ST
OK
REPLACE POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU
8
CHECK FOR DTC
(a) Check for DTCs of the hybrid vehicle control ECU.
OK:
DTCs of the hybrid vehicle control ECU are not
output
NG
OK
REPLACE POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU
GO TO HYBRID CONTROL SYSTEM
ST–70
1NZ-FXE STARTING – POWER SWITCH
POWER SWITCH
1NZ-FXE STARTING
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD
REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD
REAR DECK FLOOR BOX
ST
6.0 (61, 53 in.*lbf)
NEGATIVE BATTERY
CABLE
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
A124443E07
1NZ-FXE STARTING – POWER SWITCH
ST–71
POWER SWITCH
UPPER INSTRUMENT PANEL
FINISH PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
ST
LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL
FINISH PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY
HOOD LOCK CONTROL
CABLE ASSEMBLY
NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER ASSEMBLY
A127730E01
ST–72
1NZ-FXE STARTING – POWER SWITCH
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
CHECK POWER SWITCH MODE CHANGE FUNCTION
(a) Check the function of the power switch.
(1) Check that power switch mode changes in
accordance with the conditions of the shift
position and brake pedal.
HINT:
For vehicles with the smart entry system, the
power switch functions not only when the key is
inserted into the key slot but also when the
driver carries the key.
Specified condition
ST
Shift Position
Brake Pedal
Change of power switch mode (Arrow "→" means 1 press of power
switch)
P
Released
OFF → ON (ACC) → ON (IG) → OFF (Repeated)
P
Depressed
OFF → Hybrid system starts
P
Depressed
ON (ACC) → Hybrid system starts
P
Depressed
ON (IG) → Hybrid system starts
P
Depressed
Hybrid system operating → OFF
P
Released
Hybrid system operating → OFF
Any position other than P
Released
ON (ACC) → ON (IG)
Any position other than P
Depressed
ON (ACC) → ON (IG)
Any position other than P
Released
ON (IG) → OFF after shift position switched to P (shift-linked OFF
function)
Any position other than P
Released
Hybrid system operating → OFF after shift position switched to P
(auto P control function)
Any position other than P
Depressed
Hybrid system operating → OFF after shift position switched to P
(auto P control function)
(b) Check if power switch mode changes without
pressing the power switch.
(1) With power switch mode ON (ACC) and the
shift position in P, pull out the key. Check that
power switch mode changes from ON (ACC) to
OFF automatically.
(2) With power switch mode ON (ACC) and the
shift position in P, wait for at least 1 hour. Check
that power switch mode changes from ON
(ACC) to OFF automatically.
2.
CHECK INTERLOCK FUNCTION
(a) Insert the key into the key slot, and change power
switch modes and shift position according to the
table below. Check whether or not the key is locked
in the key slot.
Specified condition
Power Switch Mode
Shift Position
Key Status
OFF
P
Not locked in
OFF
Any position except P
-
ON (ACC)
P
Not locked in
ON (ACC)
Any position except P
Locked in
ON (IG)
P
Locked in
ON (IG)
Any position except P
Locked in
READY (hybrid system ON)
P
Locked in
ST–73
1NZ-FXE STARTING – POWER SWITCH
Power Switch Mode
Shift Position
Key Status
READY (hybrid system ON)
Any position except P
Locked in
3.
Indicator
CHECK INDICATOR CONDITION
(a) Check the power indicator on the power switch.
(1) Check that the power indicator illuminates and
changes colors according to the table below.
Specified condition
Power Switch Mode
Power Switch
Indicator Status
OFF
OFF
ON (ACC)
Green illumination
ON (IG)
Amber illumination
Hybrid system ON
OFF
Push button start system
malfunctioning
Flashes continuously in amber
B080592E02
ST
ST–74
1NZ-FXE STARTING – POWER SWITCH
REMOVAL
ST
Push
1.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
2.
REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-4)
3.
REMOVE REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH4)
4.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
5.
REMOVE NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-5)
6.
REMOVE LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page IP-6)
7.
REMOVE UPPER INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page IP-6)
8.
REMOVE POWER SWITCH
(a) Push the 2 claws and then remove the power
switch.
Push
A127732E01
INSPECTION
1.
SSW1
SSW2
B080049E04
INSPECT POWER SWITCH
(a) Measure the resistance of the switch.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
7 (SS2) - 6 (GND)
Pushed
Below 1 Ω
5 (SS1) - 6 (GND)
Pushed
Below 1 Ω
7 (SS2) - 6 (GND)
Released
10 kΩ or higher
5 (SS1) - 6 (GND)
Released
10 kΩ or higher
1NZ-FXE STARTING – POWER SWITCH
ST–75
If the resistance is not as specified, replace the
power switch.
ST
ST–76
1NZ-FXE STARTING – POWER SWITCH
INSTALLATION
ST
1.
INSTALL POWER SWITCH
(a) Install the power switch to the upper finish panel.
2.
INSTALL UPPER INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page IP-13)
3.
INSTALL LOWER INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH
PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page IP-13)
4.
INSTALL NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-13)
5.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL (See page CH-7)
6.
INSTALL REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
7.
INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX (See page CH-8)
8.
INSTALL REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD (See page CH8)
9.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
ST–76
1NZ-FXE STARTING – KEY SLOT
KEY SLOT
1NZ-FXE STARTING
ENGINE
COMPONENTS
ST
KEY SLOT
NO. 3 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER ASSEMBLY
B131353E01
ST–77
1NZ-FXE STARTING – KEY SLOT
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE NO. 3 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY
(a) Detach the claw and 5 clips.
(b) Disconnect the connector and remove the
instrument panel register.
3.
REMOVE KEY SLOT
(a) Remove the 2 screws and key slot.
B074047E05
INSPECTION
1.
B080048E02
INSPECT KEY SLOT
(a) Remove the key slot (see page ST-77).
(b) Measure the resistance of the key slot.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
3 (KSW2) - 2 (COM)
Key is in key slot
10 kΩ or higher
If the result is not as specified, replace the key slot.
(c) Inspect the key slot illumination.
(1) Connect the battery positive (+) lead from the
battery to terminal 2 and the battery negative () lead to terminal 6, then check that the
illumination comes on.
OK:
Illumination comes on.
E074066E06
ST
ST–78
1NZ-FXE STARTING – KEY SLOT
INSTALLATION
B074047E04
ST
1.
INSTALL KEY SLOT
(a) Install the key slot with the 2 screws.
2.
INSTALL NO. 3 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY
(a) Connect the connector.
(b) Attach the claw and 5 clips to install the instrument
panel register.
3.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
4.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
TD–1
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
NOTICE:
For initialization:
When disconnecting the cable from the negative (-)
battery terminal, initialize the following system after the
cable is reconnected.
System Name
Power Window Control System
See procedure
IN-32
For hybrid control system activation:
When the warning light is illuminated or the battery has
been disconnected and reconnected, pressing the power
switch may not start the system on the first try. If so,
press the power switch again.
TD
TD–2
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
TD
ENGINE HOOD COURTESY SWITCH
SECURITY HORN
HEADLIGHT
- HEADLIGHT
- HAZARD WARNING LIGHT
LOW PITCHED HORN
ENGINE ROOM JUNCTION BLOCK, RELAY BLOCK
- INTEGRATION RELAY (UNIT B: HORN RELAY)
- DC/DC H-FUSE
- P/I H-FUSE
- DOME FUSE
- HORN FUSE
HIGH PITCHED HORN
B126377E03
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
TD–3
TD
CENTER NO. 1 CONNECTOR
POWER SOURCE
CONTROL ECU
CENTER NO. 2 CONNECTOR
KEY SLOT
DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
- MAIN BODY ECU
- IG1 RELAY
- ECU-IG FUSE
- AM1 FUSE
B126379E01
TD–4
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
FRONT DOOR COURTESY LIGHT
SWITCH RH
TD
FRONT DOOR LOCK RH
ROOM LIGHT
REAR DOOR LOCK RH
SECURITY INDICATOR LIGHT
REAR DOOR COURTESY
LIGHT SWITCH RH
FRONT DOOR LOCK LH
FRONT DOOR COURTESY
LIGHT SWITCH LH
REAR DOOR LOCK LH
REAR DOOR COURTESY
LIGHT SWITCH LH
BACK DOOR LOCK
FUSIBLE LINK BLOCK
- MAIN H-FUSE
- DC/DC-S FUSE
B126378E03
TD–5
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
Door Lock Motors
Door Control Receiver
Back Door Lock Motor
Certification ECU*
Flasher Relay
Door Courtesy Switches
Taillight Relay
Back Door Courtesy
Switch
Main Body
ECU
Headlight Relay
Key (Door
Control
Transmitter)
Engine Hood Courtesy
Switch
Horn Relay
Security Horn
Door Position Switch
(P, PR, RL)
Room Light (Interior Light)
Door Lock/Unlock Switch
Security Indicator Light
Key Slot (Halfway Switch)
Network
Gateway ECU
BEAN
Power Source Control ECU
Power Switch
POWER
CAN
Hybrid Vehicle
Control ECU
ECM
*: w/ Smart Key System
B126380E01
TD
TD–6
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
Sender
Receiver
Hybrid vehicle control ECU
ECM
Power source control ECU
TD
Main body ECU
Signal
•
•
Drive OK signal
READY signal
•
•
Engine revolution signal
Engine speed signal
Power switch signal
Line
BEAN/CAN
BEAN
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
TD–7
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
(a) The theft deterrent system is designed to deter
break-in and theft. If an attempted break-in or theft
is detected, a vehicle horns and security horn will
sound; room light will light up; and hazard warning
lights, taillights and headlights will flash
continuously. The system uses the following cues to
detect an attempted break-in or theft: 1) vehicle is
forcibly entered, 2) engine hood is forcibly opened,
3) doors are unlocked without the use of a key, or 4)
the battery cables are disconnected and then
reconnected.
The system has 2 modes: active arming mode and
passive arming mode (see page TD-8). Passive
arming mode can be toggled ON and OFF (see
page TD-8).
Each mode has 4 states; disarmed state, arming
preparation state, armed state and alarm sounding
state.
(1) Disarmed state:
• The alarm function is not operating.
• The theft deterrent system is not operating.
(2) Arming preparation state:
The theft deterrent system is not operating.
(3) Armed state:
The theft deterrent system is operating (60 +-5
seconds).
(4) Alarm sounding state:
The alarm function is operating.
TD
TD–8
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
• Use these procedures to troubleshoot the theft deterrent
system.
• *: Use the intelligent tester.
TD
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
INSPECT BATTERY VOLTAGE
Standard voltage:
11 to 14 V
If the result is not as specified, recharge or replace the
battery before proceeding.
NEXT
3
INSPECT COMMUNICATION FUNCTION OF LARGE-SCALE MULTIPLEX
COMMUNICATION SYSTEM (BEAN)*
(a) Use the intelligent tester, check for normal function of the
multiplex communication system (see page TD-21).
Result:
Result
Proceed to
MPX DTC is not output
A
MPX DTC is output
B
B
Go to MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION
SYSTEM
A
4
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Result:
Result
Proceed to
Fault is not listed in problem symptoms
table
A
Fault is listed in problem symptoms
table
B
B
A
Go to step 6
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
5
OVERALL ANALYSIS AND TROUBLESHOOTING*
(a)
(b)
(c)
(d)
NEXT
6
ADJUST, REPAIR OR REPLACE
NEXT
7
NEXT
END
TD–9
CONFIRMATION TEST
Operation Check (see page TD-8)
DATA LIST/ ACTIVE TEST (see page TD-21)
Terminals of ECU (see page TD-18)
Inspection
(1) Engine hood courtesy switch (see page TD-42)
(2) Security horn (see page TD-43)
TD
TD–10
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
OPERATION CHECK
1.
TD
OUTLINE OF THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
(a) When the theft deterrent system detects that the
vehicle is being tampered with, the vehicle horns
and security horn will sound and hazard warning
lights will flash continuously.
(b) The system has 2 modes: active arming mode (refer
to "ACTIVE ARMING MODE") and passive arming
mode (refer to "PASSIVE ARMING MODE").
Passive arming mode can be turned on and off.
(c) Each mode has 4 states: disarmed state, arming
preparation state, armed state and alarm sounding
state.
(1) Disarmed state:
• The alarm function is not operating.
• The theft deterrent system is not operating.
(2) Arming preparation state:
The theft deterrent system is not operating.
(3) Armed state:
The theft deterrent system is operating.
(4) Alarm sounding state:
The theft deterrent system is operating (60 +-5
seconds).
Refer to table below for alarm method and time:
Hazard Warning Light
Vehicle Horn
Sounding (cycle of 0.4 seconds)
Security Horn
Alarm Method
Headlight
Blinking (cycle of 0.4 seconds)
Taillight
Room Light
Alarm Time
Illuminating
60 +-5 seconds
2.
System State
Disarmed state
Blinking (cycle of flasher relay)
HINT:
If, during the alarm sounding state, one of the
doors is unlocked and no key is in the key slot, a
forced door lock signal will be output (refer to
"FORCED DOOR LOCK CONTROL").
ACTIVE ARMING MODE
HINT:
Active arming mode starts the alarm control immediately
after the doors are locked.
State Switching Condition
Performing any of following will cause system
to go into "Arming preparation state"
• With all doors and engine hood closed,
lock all doors by key operation
• With all doors and engine hood closed,
lock all doors by wireless operation
• With any door or engine hood open, lock
all doors and close all doors and engine
hood
Switches to
Arming preparation state
TD–11
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
System State
Arming preparation state
Armed State
Alarm sounding state
State Switching Condition
Switches to
Performing any of following will cause system
to go into "Disarmed state"
• Unlock all doors by wireless operation
• Unlock all doors by key operation
• Unlock any door
• Open any door
• Open engine hood
• Insert key into key slot
• Reconnect battery
• Turn power switch from OFF to ON (IG)
Disarmed state
Performing following will cause system to go
into "Armed state"
With all doors and engine hood closed, lock
all doors. Allow 30 (+-1.5) seconds to elapse.
Armed state
Performing any of following will cause system
to return to "Disarmed state"
• Insert key into key slot, turn power switch
ON (IG). Run engine over 550 rpm for 10
to 12 seconds.
• Unlock any door by wireless operation
• Unlock any door by key operation
• Insert key into key slot and turn power
switch from OFF to ON (IG)
Disarmed state
Performing any of following will cause system
to start "Alarm sounding state"
• Open engine hood
• Reconnect battery
• Open any door
• Unlock any door without key and wireless
operation
• Directly connect power switch without key
(or turn power switch ON (IG) without key)
Alarm sounding state
Performing any of following will cause system
to return to "Disarmed state"
• Unlock any door by wireless operation
• Unlock any door by key operation
• Insert key into key slot and turn power
switch from OFF to ON (IG)
Disarmed state (alarm operation is canceled)
When system detects tampering, horns sound
and lights illuminate or blink.
After 60 (+-5) seconds, alarm stops and
system return to "Armed state".
Armed state (alarm stops sounding)
3.
PASSIVE ARMING MODE
HINT:
• Passive arming mode can be turned on and off (refer
to "METHOD FOR CHANGING OF PASSIVE MODE
(ON OR OFF)).
• The vehicle's initial alarm setting is active arming
mode.
• During passive arming mode, the theft deterrent
system enters the armed state even if the doors are
not locked.
• Passive arming mode starts the alarm control after
the doors are closed.
• Detecting that the doors are unlocked does not set off
the alarm during passive arming mode.
• A forced door lock signal is not output during passive
arming mode (refer to "FORCED DOOR LOCK
CONTROL").
TD
TD–12
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
• When the theft deterrent system detects that the
doors are opened during passive arming mode, the
alarm is not set off immediately depending on the
entry delay time setting.
• If one of the following conditions is fulfilled during
passive arming mode, the theft deterrent system will
be changed to active arming mode.
– With all doors and engine hood closed, lock all
doors by wireless operation.
– With all doors and engine hood closed, lock all
doors by key operation.
– With any doors or engine hood open, lock all doors
and close all doors and engine hood.
TD
System State
Disarmed state (1)*1 (no key in key slot and
smart key system is canceled)
Disarmed state (2)*2
Arming preparation state
Armed state
State Switching Condition
Switches to
Performing any of following will cause system
to go into "Disarmed state (2)"
• With power switch OFF, open any door
engine hood, and pull out key from key
slot
• With power switch OFF, pull out key from
key slot, and open any door or engine
hood
Disarmed state (2)
Performing following will cause system to go
into "Arming preparation state"
Close all doors and engine hood
Arming preparation state
Performing any of following will cause system
to return to "Disarmed state (1)"
• Unlock all doors by wireless operation
• Unlock all doors by key operation
• Reconnect battery
• Turn power switch from OFF to ON (IG)
• Insert key into key slot
Disarmed state (1)
Performing any of following will cause system
to return to "Disarmed state (1)"
• Unlock all doors by wireless operation
• Unlock all doors by key operation
• Reconnect battery
• Turn power switch from OFF to ON (IG)
• Insert key into key slot
Disarmed state (1)
Performing following will cause system to go
into "Armed state"
With all doors and engine hood closed, allow
30 (+-1.5) seconds to elapse
Armed state
Performing any of following will cause system
to return to "Disarmed state (2)"
Disarmed state (2)
Performing any of following will cause system
to return to "Disarmed state (1)"
• Unlock all doors by wireless operation
• Unlock all doors by key operation
• Insert key into key slot and turn power
switch from OFF to ON (IG)
Disarmed state (1)
Performing any of following will cause system
to "Alarm sounding state"
• Open any door and allow entry delay
time*3 to elapse
• Open engine hood
• Reconnect battery
• Directly connect power switch without key
(or push power switch ON without key)
Alarm sounding state (tampering is detected)
TD–13
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
System State
Alarm sounding state
State Switching Condition
Switches to
Performing any of following will cause system
to return to "Disarmed state (1)"
• Unlock all doors by wireless operation
• Unlock all doors by key operation
• Insert key into key slot and turn power
switch from OFF to ON (IG)
Disarmed state (1)
When system detects tampering, horns
sounds and lights illuminate or blink.
After 60 (+-5) seconds, alarm stops and
system return to "Armed state"
Armed state (alarm stops)
HINT:
*1: "Disarmed state (1)" is the normal disarmed state.
*2: "Disarmed state (2)" is set from either the "Disarmed
state (1)" or the "Arming preparation state".
*3: When a door is opened while all doors are closed
during passive arming mode, the entry delay time starts.
If the state switching condition [from armed state to
disarmed state (1)] is fulfilled during the entry delay time,
the theft deterrent system will return to disarmed state
(1). However, if the state switching condition is not
fulfilled, the theft deterrent system will assume that a
break-in or theft is occurring and sound the alarm.
The entry delay time can be selected among the
following: 0, 14 or 30 seconds.
TD
TD–14
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
4.
METHOD FOR CHANGING OF PASSIVE MODE (ON
OR OFF)
Vehicle initial condition
No key in key slot
Only driver side door is opened
All doors unlocked
TD
Within 5
seconds
Insert and remove key from key slot 3 times
: Input to the vehicle
: Output from the vehicle
Close driver side door
: CORRECT
Lock and unlock all doors 3 times by key
or wireless transmitter
*1
: INCORRECT
*2
Within 40
seconds
Open and close driver side door
*1
Lock and unlock driver side door lock
button 3 times
*1
*2
Open driver side door
2 seconds
System performs forced door lock once
(answer-back)
*1: Any door courtesy OFF to ON
*2: Any door lock UNLOCK to LOCK
E112668E02
TD–15
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
*1: Entry Delay Time
*2: Any door lock UNLOCK to LOCK
*3: Driver side door OPEN to CLOSE
*4: “Driver side door OPEN to CLOSE” is
performed once in the previous step
System performs forced door lock once
(answer-back)
*3, 4
*3
Unlock driver side door lock button
To active mode
To passive mode
Within 20
seconds Close and open driver side door twice
*2
Close and open 6 times or more
driver side door 3
to 5 times
3 times
Lock and unlock driver side door lock button *3, 4
5 times
Lock and unlock driver side door
lock button
0 sec.*1
2 seconds
4 times
14 sec.*1
30 sec.*1
System performs forced door lock once
(answer-back)
System performs forced door lock
once (answer-back)
ACTIVE MODE ON (PASSIVE MODE OFF)
PASSIVE MODE ON
E112669E02
TD
TD–16
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
5.
TD
6.
7.
FORCED DOOR LOCK CONTROL
(a) The forced door lock control also helps to prevent
the vehicle from being tampered with. When a door
is unlocked and the alarm starts, the door is forced
to lock by a forced door lock signal.
(1) Conditions that force the doors to lock:
• No key is in the key slot.
• 0.4 seconds have elapsed after the previous
output of a forced door lock signal.
• The theft deterrent system is in the alarm
sounding state of active arming mode.
• Any door is unlocked.
ALARM MEMORY FUNCTION
(a) If the alarm is set off (tampering is detected) while
the theft deterrent system is in the armed state, the
alarm memory function will record it. Whenever the
theft deterrent system is canceled, the alarm
memory function causes the taillights to illuminate
for 2 seconds in order to inform you that the alarm
has been set off.
(1) Conditions of the alarm memory function that
cause the taillights to illuminate:
When the theft deterrent system has entered
into the alarm sounding state (tampering has
been detected) even once, the taillights will
illuminate for 2 seconds if any of the following
conditions is fulfilled:
• Switched to the disarmed state from the
armed state during active arming mode.
• Switched to the disarmed state (1) from the
armed state during passive arming mode.
HINT:
For mode information about the active arming
mode, refer to "ACTIVE ARMING MODE". For
more information about the passive arming
mode, refer to "PASSIVE ARMING MODE".
PANIC ALARM CONTROL
(a) The panic alarm control activates the panic alarm
when the wireless transmitter PANIC switch is
pressed. The panic alarm control operates
independently from the theft deterrent system's
alarm control's change from the armed state to the
alarm sounding state.
(1) Conditions that cause the panic alarm control to
set off the panic alarm:
The panic alarm control sets off the panic alarm
when the PANIC switch on the wireless
transmitter is pressed for over 2.4 seconds
under the following conditions.
• The power switch is OFF or ON (ACC).
• The theft deterrent system is not in the alarm
sounding state (same for active arming mode
and passive arming mode).
TD–17
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
8.
• The panic alarm control is not operating (the
alarm is not set OFF).
(2) Conditions that cause the panic alarm control to
shut the alarm:
• Turn the power switch ON (IG).
• Any of the wireless transmitter switches are
pressed.
• 60 +- 5 seconds have pressed and the panic
alarm has ended.
• The theft deterrent system switches to the
alarm sounding state (same for active arming
mode and passive arming mode). However,
the alarm is still sounding, because the theft
deterrent system has switched to the alarm
sounding state. Conditions for canceling the
panic alarm are the same as for the alarm
control.
HINT:
For mode information about the active arming
mode, refer to "ACTIVE ARMING MODE". For
more information about the passive arming
mode, refer to "PASSIVE ARMING MODE".
SECURITY INDICATOR LIGHT OUTPUT
(a) The security indicator light turns on and off based
on output signals from the main body ECU.
However, in some cases the actual status of the
security indicator light is different from the output
signals of the main body ECU.
Output:
State of Theft Deterrent System*
Security Indicator Light
Output Signals from Main Body ECU
Actual Lighting Condition
OFF (immobiliser system is not set)
BLINKING (immobiliser system is set)
Disarmed state (1), (2)
OFF
Arming preparation state
ON
ON
Armed state
OFF
BLINKING
Alarm sounding state
ON
ON
Flashing cycle:
Time
Security Indicator Light
0.2 seconds
ON
1.8 seconds
OFF
HINT:
• *: Same for active arming mode and passive
arming mode.
• When the immobiliser system is set, the security
indicator blinks during the disarmed state and the
armed state due to the output signals from the
immobiliser system.
TD
TD–18
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
CUSTOMIZE PARAMETERS
HINT:
The following items can be customized.
NOTICE:
• When the customer requests a change in a function,
first make sure that customization of the function is
possible.
• Be sure to make a note of the current settings before
customizing.
• When troubleshooting a function, first make sure that
the function is set to the default setting.
TD
Theft deterrent system:
Display (Item)
Default
Contents
Setting
OFF
PASSIVE MODE is a function that
switches theft deterrent system
from arming preparation state to
armed state 30 seconds after key
is removed from key slot and all
doors is closed, even if doors are
not locked by wireless or door key
lock operation.
In PASSIVE MODE, theft
deterrent system will judge that a
theft is taking place and switch to
alarm sounding state if one of the
following operations are not
performed within 14 seconds (see
ENTRY DELAY below) after door
is opened:
• Unlock any door by key or
wireless operation
• Reconnect battery
• Insert key into key slot and
turn power switch ON (IG)
ON / OFF
ON
Function that allows vehicle horn
and theft deterrent horn to be
able to be used and a warning
device
ON / OFF
ENTRY DELAY (Entry delay time) 14 s
Function that changes entry delay
time (time before warning states)
0 s/14 s/ 30 s
WARN BY GLS SEN (Warning by
glass broken sensor)
Function that turns glass broken
sensor ON/OFF
ON / OFF
PASSIVE MODE (Passive arming
mode)
WARN BY HORN (Warning by
horn)
ON
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
TD–19
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
• Use the table below to help determine the cause of the
problem symptom. The potential causes of the symptoms
are listed in order of probability in the "Suspected area"
column of the table. Check each symptom by checking the
suspected areas in the order they are listed. Replace parts
as necessary.
• Inspect the fuses and relays related to this system before
inspecting the suspected areas below.
Theft deterrent system:
Symptom
Suspected area
1. Security indicator light circuit
Theft deterrent system cannot be set
See page
TD-36
2. ECU power source circuit
TD-40
3. Unlock warning switch circuit
DL-209
4. Door key and unlock switch
DL-8
5. Door courtesy switch circuit
LI-54
6. Back door courtesy switch circuit
LI-54
7. Engine hood courtesy switch circuit
TD-23
Security indicator light circuit
TD-36
1. Ignition switch circuit
TD-33
2. Unlock warning switch circuit
DL-204
Theft deterrent system can be set even when door is
open
Door courtesy switch circuit
TD-26
Horns (low pitched, high pitched) do not sound while
theft deterrent system is in warning operation
Horn circuit
TD-26
Headlights do not flash while theft deterrent system is
in warning operation
Headlight circuit
LI-38
Taillights do not flash while theft deterrent system is in
warning operation
Taillight circuit
LI-58
Hazard warning lights do not flash while theft deterrent
system is in warning operation
Warning light circuit
LI-69
Room light does not illuminate while theft deterrent
system is in warning operation
Room light circuit
LI-45
Security horn does not sounds while theft deterrent
system is in warning operation
Security horn circuit
TD-31
Headlights flash even when theft deterrent system is
not set
Headlight circuit
LI-38
Taillight flash even when theft deterrent system is not
set
Taillight circuit
LI-58
Hazard warning lights flash even when theft deterrent
system is not set
Hazard warning switch circuit
LI-69
Room light illuminates even when theft deterrent
system is not set
Room light circuit
LI-45
Security indicator light does not flash continuously
when power switch is changed from ON (IG) to OFF 10
times within 15 seconds
Alarm sounding state cannot be canceled even when
key is inserted into key slot, hybrid control system is
started and accelerator pedal is depressed for 10
seconds
TD
TD–20
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
CHECK DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK (MAIN
BODY ECU)
Vehicle Rear Side
Vehicle Front Side
TD
1D
B7
1A
B6
B5
1E
1B
1L
1D
1A
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
8
9
10
11
23
24
25
26
9
10
11
12
27
28
29
30
12
13
14
15
27
28
29
30
13
14
15
16
17
18
31
32
33
34
35
36
1B
1E
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
9
10
11
12
25
26
27
28
13
14
15
16
29
30
31
32
B5
B6
7 6 5 4 3 2 1
14 13 12 11 10 9 8
19 18 17
16 15
10 9 8 7 6 5
4
5
4
3
1L
2
1
17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10 9 8 7
26 25 24 23
1
16 15 14 13 12 11
B7
6
3 2
10 1112131415161718
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
22 21 20 19 18
1
B129460E01
(a) Disconnect the B6 ECU connector.
TD–21
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
(b) Disconnect the 1A, 1B, 1D and 1E junction block
connectors.
(c) Measure the resistance and voltage of wire harness
side connectors.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
GND (1E-17) - Body
ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
ECUB (1A-30) - Body
ground
R - Body ground
+B (ECUB) power supply
Always
10 to 14 V
ALTB (1B-1) - Body
ground
W - Body ground
+B (power system,
generator system) power
supply
Always
10 to 14 V
KSW (1E-36) - Body
ground
Y - Body ground
Key unlock warning switch
input
No key is in key slot
10 kΩ or higher
Key inserted
Below 1 Ω
Engine hood courtesy
switch
Engine hood closed
10 kΩ or higher
Engine hood open
Below 1 Ω
Driver side courtesy
switch input
Driver side door closed
10 kΩ or higher
HCTY (B6-5) - Body
ground
DCTY (1D-21) - Body
ground
P - Body ground
V - Body ground
Passenger side courtesy
switch input
Driver side door open
Below 1 Ω
Passenger side door
closed
10 kΩ or higher
Passenger side door open
Below 1 Ω
PCTY (1D-24) - Body
ground
BR - Body ground
RCTY (1D-5) - Body
ground
R - Body ground
Rear LH side courtesy
switch input
Rear LH side door closed
10 kΩ or higher
Rear LH side door open
Below 1 Ω
RCTY (1D-20) - Body
ground
R - Body ground
Rear RH side courtesy
switch input
Rear RH side door closed
10 kΩ or higher
Rear RH side door open
Below 1 Ω
BCTY (1D-7) - Body
ground
R - Body ground
Back door courtesy switch
Back door closed
10 kΩ or higher
Back door open
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
(d) Reconnect the B6 ECU connector.
(e) Reconnect the 1A, 1B, 1D and 1E junction block
connectors.
(f) Measure the voltage of the connectors.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
SIND (B5-8) - Body
ground
R - Body ground
Security indicator light
Security indicator light
illuminates (illuminates for
30 sec. in alarm sounding
state and flashes when
immobiliser system is
operating)
SEC (B6-1) - Body ground
Y - Body ground
Security horn
Security horn is sounding
(theft deterrent system is
in alarm sounding state)
Pulse generation →
Below 1 V
HAZ (1L- 17) - Body
ground
Y - Body ground
Hazard light drive
Answer-back OFF →
Answer-back ON
Pulse generation
HORN (1A-28) - Body
ground
Y - Body ground
Vehicle horn (low pitched
and high pitched)
Vehicle horn is sounding
(theft deterrent system is
in alarm sounding state)
Pulse generation →
Below 1 V
TRLY (1D-29) - Body
ground
BR - Body ground
Taillights
Taillights are flashing (theft
deterrent system is in
alarm sounding state)
Pulse generation →
Below 1 V
HRLY (B7-20) - Body
ground
G - Body ground
Headlights
Headlights are flashing
(theft deterrent system is
in alarm sounding state)
Pulse generation →
Below 1 V
3 to 6 V
TD
TD–22
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
If the result is not as specified, the junction block
(body ECU) may have a malfunction.
TD
TD–23
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
1.
DESCRIPTION
(a) Theft deterrent system data and the Diagnostic
Trouble Codes (DTCs) can be read through the
vehicle's Data Link Connector 3 (DLC3). When the
system seems to be malfunctioning, use the
intelligent tester to check for malfunctions and
perform repairs.
2.
CHECK DLC3
(a) The vehicle uses the ISO 15765-4 communication
protocol. The terminal arrangement of the DLC3
complies with SAE J1962 and matches the ISO
15765-4 format.
CG SG CANH SIL
CANL
BAT
H100769E16
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Terminal Description
SIL (7) - SG (5)
Bus "+" line
CG (4) - Body ground
Chassis ground
SG (5) - Body ground
Signal ground
BAT (16) - Body ground
Battery positive
Condition
During transmission
Always
Below 1 Ω
11 to 14 V
54 to 69 Ω
CANH (6) - CANL (14)
CANH (6) - Battery positive
HIGH-level CAN bus line
CANH (6) - CG (4)
1 kΩ or higher
Power switch OFF
CANL (14) - Battery positive
CANL (14) - CG (4)
Specified Condition
Pulse generation
LOW-level CAN bus line
1 kΩ or higher
1 MΩ or higher
1 MΩ or higher
If the result is not as specified, the DLC3 may have
a malfunction. Repair or replace the harness and
connector.
HINT:
Connect the cable of the intelligent tester (with CAN
VIM) to the DLC3, turn the power switch ON (IG)
and attempt to use the tester. If the display indicates
the message UNABLE TO CONNECT TO
VEHICLE, there is a problem either with the vehicle
or with the tester.
• If communication is normal when the tester is
connected to another vehicle, inspect the DLC3
of the original vehicle.
• If communication is still not possible when the
tester is connected to another vehicle, the
problem is probably in the tester itself. Consult
the Service Department listed in the tester's
instruction manual.
Intelligent Tester
DLC3
CAN VIM
B126098E01
TD
TD–24
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST
1.
TD
READ DATA LIST
HINT:
Using the intelligent tester's DATA LIST allows switch,
sensor, actuator and other item values to be read without
removing any parts. Reading the DATA LIST early in
troubleshooting is one way to save time.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Read the DATA LIST according to the display on the
tester.
Main body ECU:
Item
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
KEY UNLK WRN SW
Key unlock warning switch signal
/ ON or OFF
ON: Key is in key slot
OFF: No key is in key slot
-
D DOR CTY SW
Driver door courtesy switch signal
/ ON or OFF
ON: Driver side door is open
OFF: Driver side door is closed
-
P DOR CTY SW
Passenger door courtesy switch
signal / ON or OFF
ON: Passenger side door is open
OFF: Passenger side door is
closed
-
RR DOR OPEN SW
Rear door courtesy switch signal /
ON or OFF
ON: Either rear right or left door is
open
OFF: Both rear right and left
doors are closed
-
B DOR OPEN SW
Back door open switch
ON: Back door is open
OFF: Back door is closed
-
RR LOCK POS SW
Rear door lock position switch
signal / ON or OFF
ON: Rear door lock is in unlock
position
OFF: Rear door lock is in lock
position
-
P LOCK POS SW
Passenger door lock position
switch signal / ON or OFF
ON: Passenger side door lock is
in unlock position
OFF: Passenger side door lock is
in lock position
-
D LOCK POS SW
Driver door lock position switch
signal / ON or OFF
ON: Driver side door is in unlock
position
OFF: Driver side door is in lock
position
-
HOOD COURTSY SW
Engine hood courtesy switch
signal / ON or OFF
ON: Engine hood is open
OFF: Engine hood is closed
-
IG SW
Power switch signal / ON or OFF
ON: Power switch is pushed
OFF: Power switch is not pushed
-
2.
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST
HINT:
Performing the intelligent tester's ACTIVE TEST allows
relay, VSV, actuator and other items to be operated
without removing any parts. Performing the ACTIVE
TEST early in troubleshooting is one way to save time.
The DATA LIST can be displayed during the ACTIVE
TEST.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
TD–25
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
(c) Perform the ACTIVE TEST according to the display
on the tester.
Main body ECU:
Item
SECURITY INDIC
Test Detail
Diagnostic Note
Turn security indicator light ON / OFF
-
SECURITY HORN
Sound security horn ON / OFF
-
VEHICLE HORN
Sound vehicle horn ON / OFF
-
TD
TD–26
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
Engine Hood Courtesy Switch Circuit
DESCRIPTION
The engine hood courtesy switch is installed into the hood lock. This switch turns ON when the engine
hood is opened and turns OFF when the engine hood is closed.
WIRING DIAGRAM
TD
Main Body ECU
Engine Hood Courtesy Switch
HCTY
B126395E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (ENGINE HOOD COURTESY SWITCH)
(a) Check the DATA LIST for proper functioning of the
engine hood courtesy switch.
Main body ECU:
Item
HOOD COURTESY SW
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Engine hood courtesy switch
signal / ON or OFF
Normal Condition
ON: Engine hood is open
OFF: Engine hood is closed
Diagnostic Note
-
OK:
On tester screen, item changes between ON and
OFF according to above chart.
OK
NG
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
ASSEMBLY (MAIN BODY ECU)
TD–27
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
2
INSPECT ENGINE HOOD COURTESY SWITCH
(a) Remove the courtesy switch from the hood lock.
(b) Measure the resistance of the switch.
Standard resistance
Not Pushed (ON)
Tester Connection
Pushed
(OFF)
1-2
2 1
NG
B117066E01
Condition
Specified Condition
Pushed (OFF)
10 kΩ or higher
Not pushed (ON)
Below 1 Ω
REPLACE ENGINE HOOD COURTESY
SWITCH
OK
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ENGINE HOOD COURTESY SWITCH - BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the E3 switch connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Tester Connection
E3
1
E3-2 - Body ground
2
NG
B126396E01
OK
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
TD
TD–28
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (MAIN BODY ECU - ENGINE HOOD COURTESY SWITCH)
(a) Disconnect the B6 ECU connector.
(b) Disconnect the E3 switch connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Main Body ECU
TD
B6
HCTY
1
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
B6-5 (HCTY) - E3-1
Below 1 Ω
B6-5 (HCTY) or E3-1 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
4
2 3
NG
5 6 7 8 9 10
11 12 13 14 15 16
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
Engine Hood Courtesy Switch
E3
1
2
B126397E01
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
TD–29
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
Horn Circuit
DESCRIPTION
When the theft deterrent system is switched from the armed state to the alarm sounding state, the main
body ECU turns on the HORN relay, causing the horns to sound at intervals of 0.4 seconds.
WIRING DIAGRAM
TD
Main Body ECU
from Horn Switch
HORN
HORN
HORN
P/I
MAIN
High Pitched Horn
Low Pitched
Horn
B126398E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (VEHICLE HORN)
(a) Select the ACTIVE TEST, use the intelligent tester (with
CAN VIM) to generate a command, and then check the
vehicle horns operation.
Main body ECU:
Item
VEHICLE HORN
Tester Detail
Vehicle horns ON / sOFF
Diagnostic Note
-
TD–30
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
OK:
Vehicle horns sound and stop.
OK
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
ASSEMBLY (MAIN BODY ECU)
NG
2
CHECK HORN
TD
(a) Press the horn switch and check if the vehicle horns
sound.
OK:
Vehicle horns sound.
OK
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
ASSEMBLY (MAIN BODY ECU)
NG
3
INSPECT FUSE (HORN)
(a) Remove the HORN fuse from the engine room junction
block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the fuse.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE FUSE
OK
4
CHECK HORN (HORN BATTERY VOLTAGE)
(a) Disconnect the H9 and H10 horn connectors.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
H9
Tester Connection
H9-1 - Body ground
H10
H10-1 - Body ground
B126399E01
NG
OK
Condition
Horn switch pushed
REPLACE HORN
Specified Condition
10 to 14 V
TD–31
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
5
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ENGINE ROOM JUNCTION BLOCK - BATTERY)
(a) Disconnect the 3M junction block connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
Tester Connection
1
3M
3M-1 - Body ground
NG
Specified Condition
10 to 14 V
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
B126400E01
OK
6
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ENGINE ROOM JUNCTION BLOCK - HORN AND BODY
GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the 3A, 3K and 3J junction block connectors.
(b) Disconnect the H9 and H10 horn connectors.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Engine Room Junction Block
1
3A
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3A-1 - 3K-1
Below 1 Ω
3J-8 - H9-1
3J-8 - H10-1
3A-1 or 3K-1 - Body ground
3J-8 or H9-1 - Body ground
3J-8 or H10-1 - Body ground
Engine Room Junction Block
NG
3K
1
3J
2 3
4
5
6 7
8
Horn
H9
H10
B126662E01
OK
10 kΩ or higher
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
TD
TD–32
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
7
CHECK DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK ASSEMBLY (OPERATION)
(a) Reconnect the 1A junction block connector.
(b) Check that the horns sound.
OK
Wire Harness Side
Connection
1A
Junction block terminal 1A-28 and
Body ground connected
TD
2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12
13 14 15 16 17 18
19 20 21 22 2324 25 26
27 28 29 30
31 32 33 34 35 36
1
OK
Specified Condition
Horns sound
Horns do not sound
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
ASSEMBLY (MAIN BODY ECU)
B137725E01
NG
8
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK - ENGINE ROOM JUNCTION
BLOCK AND BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the 1A and 3A junction block connectors.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Tester Connection
1A-28 - 3J-7
Below 1 Ω
1A-28 or 3J-7 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
Driver Side Junction Block
1A
NG
2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12
13 14 15 16 17 18
19 20 21 22 2324 25 26
27 28 29 30
31 32 33 34 35 36
1
Engine Room Junction Block
3J
Specified Condition
1
2 3
4
5
6 7
8
B126665E01
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
TD–33
OK
REPLACE ENGINE ROOM RELAY BLOCK
TD
TD–34
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
Security Horn Circuit
DESCRIPTION
When the theft deterrent system is switched from the armed state to the alarm sounding state, the main
body ECU turns on the relay, causing the horns to sound at intervals of 0.4 seconds.
WIRING DIAGRAM
TD
Main Body ECU
SEC
Security Horn
B126393E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (SECURITY HORN)
(a) Select the ACTIVE TEST, use the intelligent tester (with
CAN VIM) to generate a command, and then check the
security horn operation.
Main body ECU:
Item
SECURITY HORN
Tester Details
Diagnostic Note
Security horn ON/OFF
-
OK:
Security horn sounds and stops.
OK
NG
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
ASSEMBLY (MAIN BODY ECU)
TD–35
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
2
INSPECT SECURITY HORN
(a) Remove the security horn.
(b) Apply battery voltage to the horn and check operation of
the horn.
OK
Tester Connection
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 1
Battery positive (-) → Horn bracket
NG
Specified Condition
Horn sounds
REPLACE SECURITY HORN
B117055
OK
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (MAIN BODY ECU - SECURITY HORN)
(a) Disconnect the B6 ECU connector.
(b) Disconnect the T1 horn connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Main Body ECU
Tester Connection
SEC
B6
1
2 3
4
Specified Condition
B6-1 (SH-) - T1-1
Below 1 Ω
B6-1 (SH-) or T1-1 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
5 6 7 8 9 10
11 12 13 14 15 16
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
Security Horn
T1
B126394E01
OK
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK ASSEMBLY (MAIN BODY ECU)
TD
TD–36
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
Ignition Switch Circuit
DESCRIPTION
When turning the power switch ON (IG), battery positive voltage is applied to terminal SIG of the main
body ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
TD
Main Body ECU
IG1
ECU-IG
SIG
DC/DC
to Power Source Control ECU
MAIN
B126384E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT FUSE (ECU-IG)
(a) Remove the ECU-IG fuse from the driver side junction
block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the fuse.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE FUSE
TD–37
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
OK
2
INSPECT IG1 RELAY
(a) Remove the IG1 relay from the driver side junction block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the relay.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
10 kΩ or higher
Below 1 Ω (when battery voltage is
applied to terminals 1 and 2)
3-5
NG
A092673E27
REPLACE IG1 RELAY
OK
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK - BATTERY)
(a) Disconnect the 1B junction block connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
Tester Connection
1B-1 - Body ground
1B
1
NG
Specified Condition
10 to 14 V
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
B126385E01
OK
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK - BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the 1E junction block connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
1E
Tester Connection
2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12
13 14 15 16
17 18 19 20 2122 23 24
25 26 27 28
29 30 31 32
1
1E-17 - Body ground
NG
B126387E01
OK
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
TD
TD–38
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
5
CHECK POWER SOURCE CONTROL ECU (IG1D VOLTAGE)
(a) Disconnect the 1J junction block connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
Tester Connection
1J
TD
1
2 3
4 5 6 7 8
1J-3 - Body ground
OK
B126388E01
Condition
Specified Condition
Power switch OFF
Below 1 V
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NG
6
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK - POWER SOURCE CONTROL
ECU AND BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the 1J junction block connector.
(b) Disconnect the P6 ECU connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Driver Side Junction Block
Tester Connection
1J
1
2 3
4 5 6 7 8
Below 1 Ω
1J-3 or P6-34 (IG1D) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
Power Source Control ECU
P6
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9
Specified Condition
1J-3 - P6-34 (IG1D)
10 11 12 13 14 15 16 17
18 19 20 21 22 23 24 25 26 27 28 29 30 31 32 33 34 35 36 37 38 39 40
IG1D
B126389E01
OK
GO TO SMART KEY SYSTEM (for Starting)
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
TD–39
Security Indicator Light Circuit
DESCRIPTION
When the theft deterrent system is in the disarmed state, the security indicator light will flash continuously
if the immobiliser system is set, or not illuminate if the immobiliser system is not set.
When the theft deterrent system is in the armed state, the immobiliser system is automatically set and the
security indicator light will flash continuously.
When the theft deterrent system is in the arming preparation state and alarm sounding state, the main
body ECU causes the security indicator light to be illuminated.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Main Body ECU
Combination Meter
Security Indicator Light
Joining Connector
SIND
Joining Connector
B126390E01
TD
TD–40
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (SECURITY INDICATOR LIGHT)
(a) Select the ACTIVE TEST, use the intelligent tester (with
CAN VIM) to generate a command, and then check the
security indicator light operation.
Main body ECU:
TD
Item
SECURITY INDIC
Tester Detail
Diagnostic Note
Security indicator light ON/OFF
-
OK:
Security indicator light turns on and off.
OK
INSPECT COMBINATION METER ECU
(SECURITY INDICATOR LIGHT)
NG
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (JOINING CONNECTOR - MAIN BODY ECU)
(a) Disconnect the IG1 joining connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Tester Connection
IG1
11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
IG1-4 - Body ground
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12
NG
B126391E01
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
TD–41
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (MAIN BODY ECU - JOINING CONNECTOR)
(a) Disconnect the B5 ECU connector.
(b) Disconnect the IG1 joining connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Main Body ECU
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
B5-8 (SIND) - IG1-1
Below 1 Ω
B5-8 (SIND) or IG1-1 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
1 2 3 4 5 6 7
B5
SIND
NG
8 9 10 11 12 13 14
15 16
17 18 19
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
Joining Connector
IG1
11 10 9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
22 21 20 19 18 17 16 15 14 13 12
B126392E01
OK
4
INSPECT COMBINATION METER ECU (SECURITY INDICATOR LIGHT)
(a) Disconnect the IG1 joining connector.
(b) Apply 12 V positive voltage to the terminals of the
combination meter.
(c) Check that the security indicator light illuminates.
OK
Wire Harness Side
Tester Connection
Body positive (+) → Terminal 1
Body negative (-) → Terminal 4
IG1
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8 9 10 11
12 13 14 15 16 17 18 19 20 21 22
B139476E01
Specified Condition
Illuminates
NOTICE:
• If the positive (+) lead and the negative (-) lead are
incorrectly connected, the security indicator light
will not illuminate.
• Applying a voltage of more than 12 V will damage
the security indicator light.
• If the voltage is too low, the security indicator will
not illuminate.
NG
GO TO METER / GAUGE SYSTEM
TD
TD–42
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
TD
TD–43
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
ECU Power Source Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This circuit provides power to operate the main body ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
TD
Main Body ECU
DOME
ECUB
MAIN
GND
B126382E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT FUSE (DOME)
(a) Remove the DOME fuse from the engine room junction
block and relay block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the fuse.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE FUSE
TD–44
THEFT DETERRENT – THEFT DETERRENT SYSTEM
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK - BATTERY AND BODY
GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the 1A and 1E junction block connectors.
Wire Harness Side
TD
Driver Side Junction Block
1A
2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12
13 14 15 16 17 18
19 20 21 22 2324 25 26
27 28 29 30
31 32 33 34 35 36
1
Driver Side Junction Block
1E
ECUB
2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12
13 14 15 16
17 18 19 20 2122 23 24
25 26 27 28
29 30 31 32
1
GND
B126383E01
(b) Measure the resistance and voltage of the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
1E-17 (GND) - Body ground
Specified Condition
Below 1 Ω
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
1A-30 (ECUB) - Body ground
NG
Specified Condition
10 to 14 V
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
TD–42
THEFT DETERRENT – ENGINE HOOD COURTESY SWITCH
ENGINE HOOD COURTESY
SWITCH
Not Pushed (ON)
Pushed
(OFF)
TD
INSPECTION
2 1
1.
B117066E01
INSPECT ENGINE HOOD COURTESY SWITCH
(a) Measure the resistance of the switch.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
1-2
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
Pushed (OFF)
10 kΩ or higher
Not pushed (ON)
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the switch.
TD–43
THEFT DETERRENT – SECURITY HORN ASSEMBLY
SECURITY HORN ASSEMBLY
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT SECURITY HORN ASSEMBLY
(a) Apply battery voltage to the horn and check the
operation of the horn.
OK
Measurement Condition
B117055
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 1
Battery negative (-) → Horn bracket
Specified Condition
Horn sounds
If the result is not as specified, replace the horn
assembly.
TD
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE AND WHEEL SYSTEM
TW–1
TIRE AND WHEEL SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
1.
2.
REMOVAL AND INSTALLATION OF THE TIRE
PRESSURE MONITOR VALVE SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) When installing a tire, make sure that the tire
pressure monitor valve sub-assembly does not
interfere with the tire bead.
(b) After completing the operation, remove the valve
core to rapidly release the air in the tire and check
that the warning light comes on. If the warning light
does not come on, the system may be defective.
(c) If there is an air leakage, tighten the nut to a force of
4.0 N*m (41 kgf*cm, 35 in.*lbf) and push the valve
core 2 or 3 times to remove any dirt attached to the
valve core. If air continues to leak, replace the
grommet, washer and nut.
(d) When installing the tire pressure monitor valve,
check whether the rim, grommet, washer and nut
are clean. Use a manufacturer-specified cap.
(e) When putting air into the tire, first install the tire
pressure valve straight onto the stem of the tire
pressure monitor valve.
TIRE AND WHEEL REPLACEMENT OR TIRE
ROTATION
(a) If replacing a tire, be sure to check the grommet of
the tire valve for damage. If necessary, replace the
grommet, washer and nut.
(b) If tires and wheels are replaced, be sure to register
the transmitter ID (see page TW-17).
(c) Transmitter IDs of all tires of the vehicle must
correspond with IDs registered in ECU.
TW
TW–2
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE AND WHEEL SYSTEM
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
1.
Check that the wheel nuts
are fully tightened.
NG
Repair
DIAGNOSIS OF TIRE VIBRATION
(a) Inspection procedure.
NG
Inspect bearing looseness.
Inspect axle hub runout.
OK
Repair tire(s).
OK
OK
Return the vehicle to
the customer.
Check tire pressure.
OK
Check wheel balance.
OK
NG
Adjustment
NG
Inspect bearing looseness.
Inspect axle hub runout.
Adjustment
NG
Repair
NG
TW
OK
Check wheel balance.
C107882E07
2.
DIAGNOSIS OF IRREGULAR TIRE WEAR
(a) Inspection procedure.
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE AND WHEEL SYSTEM
Check tire pressure.
NG
Adjustment
OK
Check wheel alignment.
OK
TW–3
Rotate or replace
the tire(s).
NG
Adjustment
NG
Check wheel alignment.
OK
C107883E01
TW
TW–4
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE AND WHEEL SYSTEM
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT TIRE
(a) Check the tires for wear and proper inflation
pressure.
Standard cold tire inflation pressure
Tire Size
Front Pressure
Rear Pressure
185/65R15 86S
240 kPa (2.4 kgf/cm2, 35
psi)
230 kPa (2.3 kgf/cm2, 33
psi)
(b) Using a dial indicator, check the tire runout (vertical
and horizontal).
Standard tire runout:
1.4 mm (0.055 in.) or less
C050798E01
Front
2.
ROTATE TIRE
HINT:
Rotate tires as shown in the illustration.
3.
INSPECT WHEEL BALANCE
(a) Check and adjust the off-the-car balance.
(b) If necessary, check and adjust the on-the-car
balance.
Standard imbalance after adjustment:
8.0 g (0.018 lb) or less
4.
INSPECT BEARING BACKLASH
(a) Inspect the front bearing backlash (see page AH-4).
5.
INSPECT FOR AXLE HUB DEVIATION
(a) Inspect for front axle hub deviation (see page AH-4).
6.
INSPECT BEARING BACKLASH
(a) Inspect the rear bearing backlash (see page AH10).
7.
INSPECT FOR AXLE HUB DEVIATION
(a) Inspect for rear axle hub deviation (see page AH10).
F008740E01
TW
C080976E01
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
TW–5
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING
SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
NOTICE:
When disconnecting the cable from the negative (-)
battery terminal, initialize the following system after the
cable is reconnected.
System Name
See procedure
Power window control system
IN-32
1.
Combination Meter
Tire Pressure
Warning Light
F100812E01
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM PRECAUTION
(a) When the tire pressure warning light turns on,
immediately check the tire pressure of each tire and
adjust it to the specified value. When the tire
pressure warning light circuit is open, the tire
pressure warning light flashes for 1 minute and then
illuminates.
NOTICE:
Check the spare tire as well since this system
only monitors the pressure of the 4 vehicle tires.
Standard pressure
Front
Rear
2
240 kPa (2.4 kgf/cm , 35 psi)
230 kPa (2.3 kgf/cm2, 33 psi)
(b) When the tire pressure warning light blinks, there is
a malfunction in the system. Check for DTCs.
(c) It is necessary to register the transmitter ID in the
tire pressure warning ECU after replacing the tire
pressure warning valve and transmitter and / or tire
pressure warning ECU (see page TW-14).
(d) When replacing the tire pressure warning ECU:
(1) Using the DATA LIST, read the transmitter IDs
registered in the ECU and make a note of them
before removing the tire pressure warning ECU.
(2) Register the transmitter IDs after installing a new
tire pressure warning ECU.
TW
TW–6
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
Transmitter ID
C107262E01
2.
3.
TW
(e) When replacing the tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter:
(1) Make a note of the 7 digit number (transmitter
ID) written on the tire pressure warning valve
and transmitter when replacing it. Register the
transmitter IDs in the tire pressure warning ECU
after replacing the tire pressure warning valve
and transmitter and installing the tires and
wheels on the vehicle.
NOTICE:
The transmitter ID is written on the tire
pressure warning valve and transmitter and
it will be unable to be read after installing the
tire pressure warning valve and transmitter
on the tire and wheel. Therefore, make a note
of the transmitter ID before installing the tire
pressure warning valve transmitter.
IN CASE OF TIRE AND WHEEL REPLACEMENT
(a) When tires and wheels are replaced, always be sure
to register the transmitter ID correctly.
FAIL-SAFE FUNCTION
(a) When a system malfunction occurs in the tire
pressure warning system, the tire pressure warning
light blinks and informs the driver of the system
failure.
(b) The result of this diagnosis is stored in the tire
pressure warning ECU.
(c) Precautions about tire pressure:
• Tire pressure decreases naturally over time.
• In winter, tire pressure may decrease due to low
ambient temperature (tire pressure decreases by
approximately 10 kPa (0.2 kgf/cm2, 1.45 psi) for
every 10°C (50°F) drop in the ambient
temperature). Therefore, the tire pressure
warning is more likely to operate if the tire
pressure are not adjusted appropriately. If the
daily temperature variation is large, pressurize
the tires high so that the tire pressures are
suitable under cold conditions. Incorrect tire
pressure warning operation becomes less likely.
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
TW–7
PARTS LOCATION
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING VALVE AND TRANSMITTER
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING VALVE AND TRANSMITTER
TW
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ANTENNA AND RECEIVER
F100810E01
TW–8
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
- IG1 RELAY
- ECU-IG FUSE
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU
DLC3
TW
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING RESET SWITCH
F100811E03
TW–9
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
Combination Meter
(Tire Pressure Warning Light)
Tire Pressure Warning Antenna
and Receiver
Combination Meter
(Vehicle Speed Signal)
Tire Pressure Warning
Valve and Transmitter
(Front LH)
Tire
Pressure
Warning
ECU
DLC3
Tire Pressure Warning
Valve and Transmitter
(Front RH)
CAN
Gateway ECU
Tire Pressure Warning
Valve and Transmitter
(Rear LH)
Tire Pressure Warning
Valve and Transmitter
(Rear RH)
TW
Tire Pressure Warning Reset Switch
Radio Signal
)
BEAN Communication Line
F100809E03
TW–10
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
Tire Pressure Warning Valve and Transmitter
DESCRIPTION OF SYSTEM
(a) A tire pressure warning valve and transmitter is
equipped with a tire pressure sensor and is installed
in each tire wheel assembly. The sensor measures
the tire pressure. The measured value and
transmitter ID are transmitted to the tire pressure
warning antenna and receiver on the body as radio
waves, and then sent to the tire pressure warning
ECU from the tire pressure warning antenna and
receiver. If the transmitter ID has already been
registered, the ECU compares the measured air
pressure value with the standard value. When the
value is less than the standard value registered in
the tire pressure warning ECU, the warning light on
the combination meter turns on.
• The tire pressure warning reset switch resets the
warning threshold in accordance with the various
tire pressure settings that exist due to tire types
and installation positions.
• The tire pressure warning valve and transmitters
may not be used on wheels other than those
originally fitted on the vehicle due to the air valve
angle of the tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter.
Tire Pressure Warning
Antenna and Receiver
Tire Pressure Warning ECU
Tire Pressure Warning
Reset Switch
TW
Tire Pressure Warning Light
DLC3
Tire Pressure Warning Valve and Transmitter
F100813E03
2.
WHEN TIRE PRESSURE WARNING LIGHT IS LIT
(a) When the tire pressure warning light does not go off,
or when it turns on during driving, check the tire
pressure. If the tire pressure warning light turns on
within several hours after adjusting the tire
pressure, the tire may have a slow air leak.
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
3.
TW–11
(b) Under the following conditions, the system may not
function properly:
• Areas, facilities or devices that use similar radio
frequencies are located in the vicinity of the
vehicle.
• Devices using similar radio frequencies are used
in the vehicle.
• Large amounts of snow or ice are stuck to the
vehicle, especially on the wheels and around the
wheel houses.
• The battery of the transmitter is depleted.
• Tires and wheels without tire pressure warning
valves and transmitters are used.
• Snow tires and tire chains are used.
• If wheels other than the specified ones are used,
the system may not function properly because
different radio waves are transmitted from the tire
pressure warning valve and transmitter.
• Depending on the tire type, the tire pressure
warning valve and transmitter may not function
properly even though the specified wheels are
used.
• The system may not function properly if it is
initialized with tire pressures which are not the
specified values.
(c) After removing and installing the ECU or a sensor,
output a diagnosis code and check that it is a
normal code.
FUNCTION OF COMPONENTS
Components
Function
Tire pressure warning valve and transmitter
Combined as a single unit with a disc wheel air valve, it measures tire
pressure and temperature, and transmits an ID number for
measurement value and identification. Built into the battery.
Tire pressure warning antenna and receiver
Receives a necessary signal from the transmitter to the tire pressure
warning ECU.
Tire pressure warning ECU
Receives the signal from the receiver and identifies it as vehicle's own
signal. If the measurement value is equal to or lower than the
specified value, it transmits a signal so that the air pressure warning
light on the combination meter turns on.
Tire pressure warning light
Located in the combination meter, it informs the driver of lowered tire
air pressure and system failure.
Tire pressure warning reset switch
Enters the initialization mode for tire or wheel replacement, or tire
rotation.
4.
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING RESET SWITCH
• By operating the tire pressure warning reset switch,
the tire pressure warning ECU can be set to issue a
warning at a specified tire pressure that corresponds
to the type of tires.
Therefore, the dealer must set the warning threshold
to the proper value in order to comply with the local
regulations.
• Operate the tire pressure warning reset switch only
after the tire pressures of all 4 tires have been
adjusted on the vehicle.
TW
TW–12
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
• To initialize the system, press and hold the tire
pressure warning reset switch for 3 seconds or longer
with the power switch ON (IG). After the system has
been initialized, the warning light blinks 3 times (1
second on, 1 second off).
• During initialization, the tire pressure warning valve
and transmitter measures the tire pressure of the
tires, and registers the signals that are transmitted
into the tire pressure warning ECU at a frequency of
one per minute. The initialization process is
completed when the signals from the 4 tires have
been received.
TW
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
TW–13
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
• Use these procedures to troubleshoot the tire pressure
warning system.
• *: Use the intelligent tester.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
INSPECT BATTERY VOLTAGE
Standard voltage:
11 to 14 V
If the voltage is below 11 V, recharge or replace the battery
before proceeding.
NEXT
3
PROBLEM SYMPTOM CONFIRMATION
NEXT
4
INSPECT COMMUNICATION FUNCTION OF MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
(BEAN)*
(a) Check for output DTCs.
HINT:
The ECM of this system is connected to the multiplex
communication system. Therefore, before starting
troubleshooting, make sure to check that there is no
trouble in the multiplex communication system.
Result
Result
Proceed to
MPX system DTC is not output
A
MPX system DTC is output
B
B
PROCEED TO MULTIPLEX
COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
A
5
CHECK CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM*
(a) Check for output DTCs.
TW
TW–14
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
HINT:
The ECM of this system is connected to the CAN
communication system. Therefore, before starting
troubleshooting, make sure to check that there is no
trouble in the CAN communication system.
Result
Proceed to
CAN system DTC is not output
A
CAN system DTC is output
B
B
PROCEED TO CAN COMMUNICATION
SYSTEM
A
6
CHECK FOR DTC (OTHER THAN MPX AND CAN SYSTEM)
(a) Check for a DTC and note any codes that are output.
(b) Delete the DTC.
(c) Recheck for DTCs, and try to prompt the DTC by
simulating the original activity that the DTC suggests.
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC does not reoccur
A
DTC reoccurs
B
B
Go to step 9
A
7
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Result
Result
Proceed to
Fault is not listed in problem symptoms table
A
Fault is listed in problem symptoms table
B
B
TW
Go to step 9
A
8
OVERALL ANALYSIS AND TROUBLESHOOTING*
(a) DATA LIST/ACTIVE TEST (see page TW-28).
(b) Terminals of ECU (see page TW-23).
NEXT
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
9
TW–15
REPAIR OR REPLACE
NEXT
10
CONFIRMATION TEST
(a) Check for DTC (see page TW-27).
(b) Perform initialization (see page TW-17).
(c) Confirm that the initialization has been completed.
NEXT
END
TW
TW–16
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
REGISTRATION
7-digit number
Transmitter ID
C124986E03
1.
IN CASE OF TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU
REPLACEMENT
(a) Read the ID stored in the old ECU using the
intelligent tester.
2.
IN CASE OF TIRE PRESSURE WARNING VALVE AND
TRANSMITTER AND/OR TIRE PRESSURE WARNING
ECU REPLACEMENT
(a) Read the ID written on the tire pressure warning
valve.
3.
REGISTER TRANSMITTER ID
NOTICE:
It is necessary to register the transmitter ID in the
tire pressure warning ECU when replacing the tire
pressure warning valve and transmitter and/or tire
pressure warning ECU.
(a) Prepare all transmitter ID data before starting
registration.
HINT:
• Read the registered transmitter IDs that are
stored in the ECU using the intelligent tester and
note them down.
• If reading stored transmitter IDs is impossible
due to malfunctions of components such as the
tire pressure warning antenna and receiver,
remove the tires from the wheels and check the
IDs written on the tire pressure warning valves
and transmitters (see page TW-71).
• When replacing the tire pressure warning valves
and transmitters, note down the IDs written on
the tire pressure warning valves and
transmitters.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) *1: Read and write down the ID (ID1 to ID4) by
using the DATA LIST.
(e) *2: Select REGIST TIRE by following the prompts
on the intelligent tester screen. (UTILITY - REGIST
TIRE)
(f) *3: Select the registration mode "MAIN".
TW
C110646
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
TW–17
(g) *4: Input the ID (ID1 to ID4) using the intelligent
tester and transmit it to the tire pressure warning
ECU.
C110645
(h) Check that "THE REGISTRATION SUCCEEDED"
appears on the intelligent tester screen.
HINT:
The previously registered IDs will be deleted from
the memory when the registration is completed. If
the operations of steps *1 to *4 do not complete
within 5 minutes, the mode will return to normal
operation mode.
C107265
TW
TW–18
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
TW
C136882
4.
CONFIRMATION OF TRANSMITTER ID
REGISTRATION
(a) Set the tire pressure of the 4 tires to the specified
value.
Standard pressure
Front
240 kPa (2.4 kgf/cm
Rear
2,
35 psi)
230 kPa (2.3 kgf/cm2, 33 psi)
(b) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
TW–19
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Select "SIGNAL CHECK" mode on the intelligent
tester (see page TW-19).
(e) Confirm that the transmitter IDs and the data of tire
pressure of all the tires are displayed on the
intelligent tester screen.
NOTICE:
• It may take up to 1 minute to update the tire
pressure data.
• If the IDs have not been registered, DTC
C2171/71 is set in the tire pressure warning
ECU after approximately 60 minutes.
TW
TW–20
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
INITIALIZATION
1.
INITIALIZATION
NOTICE:
• Perform the tire pressure warning system
initialization after the transmitter ID registration
has been completed.
• The initialization is necessary when one of the
following situations applies:
- Tire pressure warning ECU is replaced.
- Tires are replaced with those of different
pressures.
- Tire pressure warning valve and transmitters are
replaced.
- Vehicle is newly delivered.
(a) Set the tire air pressure for the 4 wheels to the
specified value.
Standard pressure
Front
240 kPa (2.4
Rear
kgf/cm2,
35 psi)
230 kPa (2.3 kgf/cm2, 33 psi)
(b) Keep the tire pressure warning reset switch pressed
for 3 seconds or more with the power switch ON
(IG).
(c) Check that the tire pressure warning light blinks 3
times at 1 second intervals.
HINT:
The initialization is complete when the tire pressure
warning ECU has received signals from all of the
wheels.
Tire Pressure
Warning Light
Tire Pressure Warning
Reset Switch
TW
Tire Pressure Warning Light
Output Pattern
1 sec.
ON
OFF
1 sec.
F100814E01
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
CG
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 12 13 14 15 16
TC
F100115E41
TW–21
(d) Wait for 2 or 3 minutes with the power switch ON
(IG).
NOTICE:
• The initialization is normally completed
within 2 to 3 minutes.
• If the initialization has not been completed
successfully, DTC C2177/77 is set
approximately 20 minutes after driving starts.
• The initialization can be terminated by
making a short circuit between terminals TC
and CG of the DLC3 connector.
(e) Confirm that the initialization has been completed
using the intelligent tester.
(1) Change the mode to test mode using intelligent
tester and check that test DTCs have been
stored.
• The test DTCs will not be indicated until the
system initialization is complete.
• After the initialization has been completed
successfully, the test DTCs (C2181/81 to
C2191/91) are indicated.
NOTICE:
The following operations can be used
instead of above procedure:
1. Turn the power switch from OFF to ON
(IG).
2. Monitor the tire pressure values of all the
wheels using intelligent tester.
3. If the tire pressure values cannot be
displayed on the intelligent tester screen, the
initialization has failed.
4. It takes 2 to 3 minutes to display the tire
pressure data.
HINT:
In winter, as the tire pressure may decrease
depending on the ambient temperature,
increase the tire pressure by 20 kPa (0.2 kgf/
cm2, 2.9 psi) to 30 kPa (0.3 kgf/cm2, 4.3 psi)
above the specified value after confirmation that
the initialization has been completed.
(f) Initialization is completed.
TW
TW–22
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
TEST MODE PROCEDURE
1.
TEST MODE CHECK
HINT:
• When entering the TEST MODE, the tire pressure
warning ECU sets all the test DTCs first. After
completing the test mode for each inspection item, the
DTCs that are determined normal by the tire pressure
warning ECU will be erased. The DTCs for other
inspection items may not be erased when only a
certain signal is inspected.
• When the test mode returns back to the normal mode,
all the test DTCs will be erased.
(a) Make sure that the power switch is OFF.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
Intelligent Tester
CAN VIM
A082795E11
(d) Select the TEST MODE on the intelligent tester.
TW
C122887
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
2.
0.125 sec.
ON
OFF
0.125 sec.
F100632E02
TW–23
(e) Confirm that the tire pressure warning light in the
combination meter blinks at 0.125 second intervals.
PERFORM SIGNAL CHECK
HINT:
• When entering signal check, the tire pressure warning
ECU sets all the signal check DTCs first.
After completing signal check for each inspection
item, the DTCs that are determined to be normal by
the tire pressure warning ECU will be erased.
The DTCs for other inspection items may not be
erased when only a certain signal is inspected.
• When the signal check returns to normal mode, all the
signal check DTCs will be erased.
(a) Make sure that the power switch is OFF.
(b) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Select the SIGNAL CHECK on the intelligent tester.
Intelligent Tester
CAN VIM
A082795E11
TW
C110644
(e) Drive the vehicle at 12 mph (20 km/h) or more for 30
seconds or more.
TW–24
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
(f)
Loosen the valve core and rapidly reduce the
pressure (above 40 kPa (0.4 kgf/cm2, 5.8 psi) /30
sec.).
HINT:
The transmitter ID can be transmitted by rapidly
reducing the tire pressure.
(g) Check that the tire pressure warning system test
mode DTCs are erased.
SIGNAL CHECK DTC
Test Signal
Signal Check DTC Clear Condition
C2181 to C2184
Transmitter Data
Receive DATA from the transmitter which has
a registered ID in tire pressure warning ECU
C2191
Vehicle Speed Signal
Vehicle speed of 12 mph (20 km/h) or more is
detected for 3 seconds or more
(h) Result
HINT:
After the signal check is completed, check for a
DTC and signal check DTC to confirm the system
status.
Condition
Procedure
SIGNAL CHECK DTC is output
Repair the faulty part and enter SIGNAL CHECK again
SIGNAL CHECK DTCs are cleared
No problem
(i)
(j)
End of SIGNAL CHECK
After completing test mode (SIGNAL CHECK), turn
the power switch OFF and disconnect the tester.
DTC of SIGNAL CHECK (TEST DIAGNOSIS)
HINT:
If a malfunction code is displayed during the test
mode DTC check, check the circuit listed for that
code. For details of each code, refer to the relevant
page listed under the respective "DTC No." in the
chart.
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
See page
C2181/81
Transmitter ID1 not received
•
Tire pressure warning
antenna and receiver
Each tire pressure warning
valve and transmitter
Tire pressure warning ECU
Wire harness
TW-35
Tire pressure warning
antenna and receiver
Each tire pressure warning
valve and transmitter
Tire pressure warning ECU
Wire harness
TW-35
Tire pressure warning
antenna and receiver
Each tire pressure warning
valve and transmitter
Tire pressure warning ECU
Wire harness
TW-35
Tire pressure warning
antenna and receiver
Each tire pressure warning
valve and transmitter
Tire pressure warning ECU
Wire harness
TW-35
•
•
•
C2182/82
Transmitter ID2 not received
TW
•
•
•
•
C2183/83
Transmitter ID3 not received
•
•
•
•
C2184/84
Transmitter ID4 not received
•
•
•
•
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
See page
C2191/91
Vehicle speed signal error
•
•
•
•
TW-53
Vehicle speed sensor
Combination meter
Tire pressure warning ECU
Wire harness
TW–25
TW
TW–26
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
• Use the table below to help determine the cause of the
problem symptom. The potential causes of the symptoms
are listed in order of probability in the "Suspected area"
column of the table. Check each symptom by checking the
suspected areas in the order they are listed. Replace parts
as necessary.
• Inspect the fuses and relays related to this system before
inspecting the suspected areas below.
Tire pressure warning system
Symptom
Tire pressure warning system does not operate.
DTC check cannot be performed.
Tire pressure warning light malfunctions (does not light
up).
Tire pressure warning light malfunctions (remains on).
Tire pressure warning light malfunctions (blinking).
Initialization cannot be performed.
TW
Suspected area
See page
1. Power source circuit
TW-60
2. TC and CG terminal circuit
TW-62
3. Tire pressure warning valve and transmitter
TW-72
4. Combination meter
ME-46
5. Tire pressure warning antenna and receiver
TW-68
6. Tire pressure warning ECU
TW-23
1. Power source circuit
TW-60
2. TC and CG terminal circuit
TW-62
3. Tire pressure warning ECU
TW-23
1. Power source circuit
TW-60
2. Tire pressure warning light circuit
TW-58
3. Combination meter
ME-11
4. Tire pressure warning ECU
TW-23
1. Tire pressure check
TW-3
2. Tire pressure warning ECU connector poorly connected
-
3. Tire pressure warning light circuit
TW-58
4. Combination meter
ME-11
5. Tire pressure warning ECU
TW-23
1. Check DTC
TW-27
2. TC and CG terminal circuit
TW-62
3. Test mode (SIGNAL CHECK)
TW-19
4. Tire pressure warning ECU
TW-23
1. Combination meter
ME-46
2. Tire pressure warning reset switch circuit
TW-55
3. Tire pressure warning ECU
TW-23
TW–27
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
CHECK TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU
T11
F100629E05
(a) Measure the voltage of the connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
IG (T11-1) - GND (T11-7)
B - W-B
IG power source
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 16 V
CLSW (T11-2) - GND
(T11-7)
GR - W-B
Tire pressure warning
reset switch
Power switch ON (IG),
Tire pressure warning
reset switch on
8 to 15 V
CLSW (T11-2) - GND
(T11-7)
GR - W-B
Tire pressure warning
reset switch
Power switch ON (IG),
Tire pressure warning
reset switch off
Below 1.5 V
MPX1 (T11-6) - GND
(T11-7)
W - W-B
Multiplex communication
line
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 16 V
RDA (T11-9) - GND (T117)
B - W-B
Tire pressure warning
antenna and receiver
signal
Power switch ON (IG),
when the tire pressure
warning antenna and
receiver is not connected
9 to 16 V
RF5V (T11-10) - GND
(T11-7)
R - W-B
Tire pressure warning
antenna and receiver
power source
Power switch ON (IG)
4.5 to 5.5 V
MPX2 (T11-12) - GND
(T11-7)
B - W-B
Multiplex communication
line
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 16 V
GND2 (T11-4) - GND
(T11-7)
G - W-B
Tire pressure warning
antenna and receiver
ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, the ECU may have a
malfunction.
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
CG
SG CANH
1.
SIL
1 2 3 4 5 6 7 8
9 10 11 1213141516
CANL
CHECK DLC3
(a) The ECM uses ISO 15765-4 for communication.
The terminal arrangement of the DLC3 complies
with SAE J1962 and matches the ISO 15765-4
format.
BAT
A082779E39
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
SIL (7) - SG (5)
Bus "+" line
During transmission
Pulse generation
CG (4) - Body ground
Chassis ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
SG (5) - Body ground
Signal ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
BAT (16) - Body ground
Battery positive
Always
11 to 14 V
CANH (6) - CANL (14)
HIGH - level CAN bus line
Power switch is OFF*
54 to 69 Ω
TW
TW–28
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
CANH (6) - Battery positive
HIGH - level CAN bus line
Power switch is OFF*
1 MΩ or higher
CANH (6) - CG (4)
HIGH - level CAN bus line
Power switch is OFF*
1 kΩ or higher
CANL (14) - Battery positive
LOW-level CAN bus line
Power switch is OFF*
1 MΩ or higher
CANL (14) - CG (4)
LOW-level CAN bus line
Power switch is OFF*
1 kΩ or higher
NOTICE:
*: Before measuring the resistance, leave the
vehicle as is for at least 1 minute and do not
operate the power switch, other switches or the
doors.
If the result is not as specified, the DLC3 may have
a malfunction. Repair or replace the harness and
connector.
HINT:
Connect the cable of the intelligent tester (with CAN
VIM) to the DLC3, turn the power switch ON (IG)
and attempt to use the tester. If the screen displays
UNABLE TO CONNECT TO VEHICLE, there may
be a problem on the vehicle side or the tester side.
• If communication is normal when the tester is
connected to another vehicle, inspect the DLC3
of the original vehicle.
• If communication is still not possible when the
tester is connected to another vehicle, the
problem may be in the tester itself. Consult the
Service Department listed in the tester's
instruction manual.
2.
Combination Meter
Tire Pressure
Warning Light
F100812E01
TW
3.
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
(a) Warning light
(1) When there is a problem with the tire pressure
warning system, the tire pressure warning light
blinks at 0.5 second intervals.
NOTICE:
When the malfunction has been corrected,
the tire pressure warning light does not turn
on.
(b) DTCs (normal mode)
(1) DTCs are memorized in the tire pressure
warning ECU and read by the blinks of the tire
pressure warning light or using the intelligent
tester (see page TW-27).
(c) Test mode
(1) By switching from normal mode into test mode
(input signal check), you can inspect the tire
pressure warning antenna and receiver, each
tire pressure warning valve and transmitter and
vehicle speed sensor (see page TW-17).
CHECK WARNING LIGHT
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
TW–29
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
(b) Check that the tire pressure warning light comes on
for 3 seconds.
If the warning check result is not normal, proceed to
the troubleshooting for the tire pressure warning
light circuit.
Combination Meter
Tire Pressure
Warning Light
Trouble Area
See procedure
Tire pressure warning light circuit
TW-58
4.
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING LIGHT
HINT:
The table below indicates the state of the tire pressure
warning light after the power switch is turned ON (IG).
F100812E01
Immediately
after turning the
power switch ON
(IG)
Always
Turns on for 3
sec.
Turns off
Normal
{
{
Low tire pressure
{
System fail
{
Test mode
{
Initialization
{
Warning light output pattern
Blinks (*1)
(Warning light
flashes for 1
minute and then
remains on)
Blinks (*2)
Blinks (*3)
{
{
{
{
{
ECU connector
poorly connected
TC ground
Turns on
{
*1: Comes on and goes off repeatedly at 0.5 second
intervals.
HINT:
The tire pressure warning light blinks for approximately 1
minute and then remains on.
0.5 sec.
ON
OFF
0.5 sec.
60 sec.
F101087E02
*2: Comes on and goes off repeatedly at 0.125 second
intervals.
0.125 sec.
ON
OFF
0.125 sec.
C110635E04
TW
TW–30
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
*3: Blinks 3 times (1 second on, 1 second off).
1 sec.
ON
OFF
1 sec.
C110636E03
DTC CHECK / CLEAR
1.
DLC3
CG
TC
Combination Meter
Normal System Code
0.25 sec.
ON
OFF
0.25 sec.
Code 13 and 33
1.5 sec.
0.5 sec. 2.5 sec.
4.5 sec.
ON
OFF
1.5 sec.
0.5 sec.
Trouble Area
See procedure
Tire pressure warning light circuit
TW-58
• If 2 or more malfunctions are indicated at the
same time, the lowest numbered DTC is
displayed first.
(d) Refer to the Diagnostic Trouble Code Chart (see
page TW-29) for DTC information.
(e) Using SST, connect terminals TC and CG of DLC3.
SST 09843-18040
Tire Pressure
Warning Light
TW
CHECK DTC (USING SST CHECK WIRE)
(a) Using SST, connect terminals TC and CG of DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Read and record any DTCs from the tire pressure
warning light on the combination meter. Refer to the
illustration on the left for examples of a normal
system code and codes 13 and 33.
HINT:
• If the tire pressure warning light does not blink
any DTCs or the normal system code, inspect
the tire pressure warning light circuit or TC and
CG terminal circuit.
Repeat
F100815E01
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
2.
Intelligent Tester
CAN VIM
A082795E11
3.
TW–31
CHECK DTC (USING INTELLIGENT TESTER)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Read the DTCs by following the prompts on the
tester screen.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual for
further details.
CLEAR DTC
HINT:
After repairing the malfunctions, clear the DTCs.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Erase the DTCs by following the prompts on the
tester screen.
HINT:
Refer to the intelligent tester operator's manual for
further details.
TW
TW–32
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST
1.
READ DATA LIST
HINT:
Using the intelligent tester's DATA LIST allows switch,
sensor, actuator and other item values to be read without
removing any parts. Reading the DATA LIST early in
troubleshooting is one way to save time.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and press the
intelligent tester main switch on.
(c) Read the DATA LIST by following the directions on
the tester screen.
Tire pressure warning ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
MODE STATUS
Tire pressure warning system
mode / NORMAL or REG 2nd or
REG M or TEST
NORMAL: Normal mode
TEST: Test mode
-
MAIN TIRE
Number of main tire ID to be
registered / 0 or 1 or 2 or 3 or 4
0 to 4 should be displayed
-
INITIAL SW
Initialization switch / ON or OFF
ON: Switch on
OFF: Switch off
-
VEHICLE SPEED
Vehicle speed reading / min.: 0
km/h (0 mph), max.: 255 km/h
(158 mph)
Actual vehicle speed
Speed indicated on the
combination meter
REGIT ID1 CODE
Registered ID1 code / min.: 0,
max.: FFFFFFF
The ID No. registered in the
transmitter ID1 is displayed
-
REGIT ID2 CODE
Registered ID2 code / min.: 0,
max.: FFFFFFF
The ID No. registered in the
transmitter ID2 is displayed
-
REGIT ID3 CODE
Registered ID3 code / min.: 0,
max.: FFFFFFF
The ID No. registered in the
transmitter ID3 is displayed
-
REGIT ID4 CODE
Registered ID4 code / min.: 0,
max.: FFFFFFF
The ID No. registered in the
transmitter ID4 is displayed
-
TRANS STATUS
ID code transmission status /
FINISH or NOW
FINISH or NOW
-
TIREPRESS1
ID1 tire inflation pressure / min.: 0
Actual tire inflation pressure
-
Actual tire inflation pressure
-
Actual tire inflation pressure
-
Actual tire inflation pressure
-
kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi), max.:
637.5 kPa (6.48 kgf/cm2, 92.2
psi)
TIREPRESS2
ID2 tire inflation pressure / min.: 0
kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi), max.:
637.5 kPa (6.48 kgf/cm2, 92.2
psi)
TW
TIREPRESS3
ID3 tire inflation pressure / min.: 0
kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi), max.:
637.5 kPa (6.48 kgf/cm2, 92.2
psi)
TIREPRESS4
ID4 tire inflation pressure / min.: 0
kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi), max.:
637.5 kPa (6.48 kgf/cm2, 92.2
psi)
TIRE TEMP1
ID1 temperature in tire / min.: 40°C (-40°F), max.: 215°C
(419°F)
Actual tire temperature
-
TIRE TEMP2
ID2 temperature in tire / min.: 40°C (-40°F), max.: 215°C
(419°F)
Actual tire temperature
-
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
TIRE TEMP3
ID3 temperature in tire / min.: 40°C (-40°F), max.: 215°C
(419°F)
Actual tire temperature
-
TIRE TEMP4
ID4 temperature in tire / min.: 40°C (-40°F), max.: 215°C
(419°F)
Actual tire temperature
-
BATT VOLT1
ID1 battery voltage / OVER or
LESS
OVER
-
BATT VOLT2
ID2 battery voltage / OVER or
LESS
OVER
-
BATT VOLT3
ID3 battery voltage / OVER or
LESS
OVER
-
BATT VOLT4
ID4 battery voltage / OVER or
LESS
OVER
-
INITIAL SW INFO
Initialization switch setting
information / WITH or WITHOUT
WITH or WITHOUT
-
ID1 initial threshold of low-
Threshold pressure after
initialization
-
Threshold pressure after
initialization
-
Threshold pressure after
initialization
-
Threshold pressure after
initialization
-
Min.: 0, Max.: -
-
INIT THRESHOLD1
pressure / min.: 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2,
0 psi), max.: 637.5 kPa (6.48 kgf/
TW–33
cm2, 92.2 psi)
INIT THRESHOLD2
ID2 initial threshold of lowpressure / min.: 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2,
0 psi), max.: 637.5 kPa (6.48 kgf/
cm2, 92.2 psi)
INIT THRESHOLD3
ID3 initial threshold of lowpressure / min.: 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2,
0 psi), max.: 637.5 kPa (6.48 kgf/
cm2, 92.2 psi)
INIT THRESHOLD4
ID4 initial threshold of lowpressure / min.: 0 kPa (0 kgf/cm2,
0 psi), max.: 637.5 kPa (6.48 kgf/
cm2, 92.2 psi)
# CODES
Number of DTC recorded / min.:
0, max.: 255
TW
TW–34
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
DIAGNOSTIC TROUBLE CODE CHART
HINT:
• If no abnormality is found when the parts are inspected,
inspect the tire pressure warning ECU.
• If a malfunction code is displayed during the DTC check,
inspect the circuit listed for that code. For details of each
code, refer to the "DTC No." in the DTC chart.
DTC chart of tire pressure warning
DTC No.
TW
Detection Item
Trouble Area
See page
C2111/11
Transmitter ID1 Operation Stop
1. Tire pressure warning valve
and transmitter
2. Tire pressure warning ECU
TW-32
C2112/12
Transmitter ID2 Operation Stop
1. Tire pressure warning valve
and transmitter
2. Tire pressure warning ECU
TW-32
C2113/13
Transmitter ID3 Operation Stop
1. Tire pressure warning valve
and transmitter
2. Tire pressure warning ECU
TW-32
C2114/14
Transmitter ID4 Operation Stop
1. Tire pressure warning valve
and transmitter
2. Tire pressure warning ECU
TW-32
C2121/21
No Signal from Transmitter ID1 in
Main Mode
1. Tire pressure warning valve
and transmitter
2. Tire pressure warning antenna
and receiver
3. Tire pressure warning ECU
4. Wire harness
TW-35
C2122/22
No Signal from Transmitter ID2 in
Main Mode
1. Tire pressure warning valve
and transmitter
2. Tire pressure warning antenna
and receiver
3. Tire pressure warning ECU
4. Wire harness
TW-35
C2123/23
No Signal from Transmitter ID3 in
Main Mode
1. Tire pressure warning valve
and transmitter
2. Tire pressure warning antenna
and receiver
3. Tire pressure warning ECU
4. Wire harness
TW-35
C2124/24
No Signal from Transmitter ID4 in
Main Mode
1. Tire pressure warning valve
and transmitter
2. Tire pressure warning antenna
and receiver
3. Tire pressure warning ECU
4. Wire harness
TW-35
C2141/41
Transmitter ID1 Error
1. Tire pressure warning valve
and transmitter
TW-41
C2142/42
Transmitter ID2 Error
1. Tire pressure warning valve
and transmitter
TW-41
C2143/43
Transmitter ID3 Error
1. Tire pressure warning valve
and transmitter
TW-41
C2144/44
Transmitter ID4 Error
1. Tire pressure warning valve
and transmitter
TW-41
C2165/65
Abnormal Temperature Inside ID1
Tire
1. Tire pressure warning valve
and transmitter
2. Tire pressure warning antenna
and receiver
TW-43
C2166/66
Abnormal Temperature Inside ID2
Tire
1. Tire pressure warning valve
and transmitter
2. Tire pressure warning antenna
and receiver
TW-43
TW–35
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
DTC No.
Detection Item
Trouble Area
See page
C2167/67
Abnormal Temperature Inside ID3
Tire
1. Tire pressure warning valve
and transmitter
2. Tire pressure warning antenna
and receiver
TW-43
C2168/68
Abnormal Temperature Inside ID4
Tire
1. Tire pressure warning valve
and transmitter
2. Tire pressure warning antenna
and receiver
TW-43
C2171/71
Transmitter ID not Registered in
Main Mode
1. Tire pressure warning ECU
TW-46
C2176/76
Receiver Error
1. Tire pressure warning antenna
and receiver
2. Tire pressure warning ECU
3. Wire harness
TW-48
C2177/77
Initialization not Completed
1. Tire pressure warning valve
and transmitter
2. Tire pressure warning ECU
TW-52
C2181/81
Transmitter ID1 not Received
(Test Mode DTC)
1. Tire pressure warning valve
and transmitter
2. Each tire pressure warning
valve and transmitter
3. Tire pressure warning ECU
4. Wire harness
TW-35
C2182/82
Transmitter ID2 not Received
(Test Mode DTC)
1. Tire pressure warning valve
and transmitter
2. Each tire pressure warning
valve and transmitter
3. Tire pressure warning ECU
4. Wire harness
TW-35
C2183/83
Transmitter ID3 not Received
(Test Mode DTC)
1. Tire pressure warning valve
and transmitter
2. Each tire pressure warning
valve and transmitter
3. Tire pressure warning ECU
4. Wire harness
TW-35
C2184/84
Transmitter ID4 not Received
(Test Mode DTC)
1. Tire pressure warning valve
and transmitter
2. Each tire pressure warning
valve and transmitter
3. Tire pressure warning ECU
4. Wire harness
TW-35
C2191/91
Vehicle Speed Signal Error (Test
Mode DTC)
1. Vehicle speed sensor
2. Tire pressure warning ECU
3. Combination meter
4. Wire harness
TW-53
TW
TW–36
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
DTC
C2111/11 Transmitter ID1 Operation Stop
DTC
C2112/12 Transmitter ID2 Operation Stop
DTC
C2113/13 Transmitter ID3 Operation Stop
DTC
C2114/14 Transmitter ID4 Operation Stop
DESCRIPTION
The tire pressure warning valve and transmitter that is installed in the tires and wheels measures the air
pressure of the tires. The measured values are transmitted to the tire pressure warning antenna and
receiver on the body as radio waves and then sent to the tire pressure warning ECU. The ECU compares
the measured air pressure values with the air pressure threshold. When the measured air pressure values
are less than this threshold, the warning light in the combination meter turns on.
The tire pressure warning ECU stores a DTC when the tire pressure warning valve stops transmitting
signals. At this time, forcibly transmit the signals by releasing the tire pressure rapidly. The stored DTC is
cleared when the signal transmission is resumed.
DTC No
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C2111/11
C2112/12
C2113/13
C2114/14
Tire pressure monitor valve stops transmitting
signals
•
•
Tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter
Tire pressure warning ECU
HINT:
It is necessary to perform the procedure to identify the tire pressure monitor valve that is malfunctioning
because it cannot be identified by the output DTC.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Tire Pressure Warning Antenna and Receiver
TW
Tire Pressure Warning ECU
+5V
RF5V
RDA
RDA
GND
GND2
E118453E14
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
TW–37
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
It is necessary to register an ID code after replacing the tire pressure warning antenna and
receiver and/or the tire pressure warning ECU (see page TW-14).
1
PERFORM FORCED TRANSMISSION OF TRANSMITTER ID OF ALL WHEELS
(a) Set the pressure of each tire to the specified value.
Standard pressure
Front
Rear
2
240 kPa (2.4 kgf/cm , 35 psi)
230 kPa (2.3 kgf/cm2, 33 psi)
(b) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Select TIREPRESS by following the prompts displayed
on the intelligent tester.
Tire pressure warning ECU
Item
Measurement item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
TIREPRESS1
ID1 tire pressure / min.: 0 kPa
Actual tire pressure
-
Actual tire pressure
-
Actual tire pressure
-
Actual tire pressure
-
(0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi), max.: 637.5
kPa (6.48 kgf/cm2, 92.2 psi)
TIREPRESS2
ID2 tire pressure / min.: 0 kPa
(0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi), max.: 637.5
kPa (6.48 kgf/cm2, 92.2 psi)
TIREPRESS3
ID3 tire pressure / min.: 0 kPa
(0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi), max.: 637.5
kPa (6.48 kgf/cm2, 92.2 psi)
TIREPRESS4
ID4 tire pressure / min.: 0 kPa
(0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi), max.: 637.5
kPa (6.48 kgf/cm2, 92.2 psi)
(e) Rapidly release the pressure from each wheel by
approximately 40 kPa (0.4 kgf/cm2, 5.8 psi) for 30
seconds or more.
(1) Check that each tire pressure data displayed on the
intelligent tester screen changes.
OK:
The tire pressure data displayed on the
intelligent tester screen changes with the
value of the tire pressure.
NOTICE:
• It may take up to 1 minute to display the
updated tire pressure data.
• When the TIREPRESS data (IDs 1 to 4)
changes, reset the tire pressure of the tires to
the specified value, rotate the tires 90 to 270°
and recheck.
(2) After confirming that the tire pressure data displayed
on the intelligent tester screen has changed, set the
pressure of each tire to the specified value.
TW
TW–38
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
Standard pressure
Front
Rear
240 kPa (2.4 kgf/cm2, 35 psi)
230 kPa (2.3 kgf/cm2, 33 psi)
HINT:
If the tire pressure data displayed on the intelligent
tester screen has not changed after rechecking, go
to the troubleshooting procedures of DTCs C2121/
21 to C2124/24 which indicate transmission or
reception malfunctions (see page TW-35).
NG
OK
END
TW
CHECK OTHER PROBLEM (MALFUNCTION
IN TRANSMISSION OR RECEPTION
FUNCTION)
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
TW–39
DTC
C2121/21 No Signal from Transmitter ID1 in Main Mode
DTC
C2122/22 No Signal from Transmitter ID2 in Main Mode
DTC
C2123/23 No Signal from Transmitter ID3 in Main Mode
DTC
C2124/24 No Signal from Transmitter ID4 in Main Mode
DTC
C2181/81 Transmitter ID1 not Received (Test Mode DTC)
DTC
C2182/82 Transmitter ID2 not Received (Test Mode DTC)
DTC
C2183/83 Transmitter ID3 not Received (Test Mode DTC)
DTC
C2184/84 Transmitter ID4 not Received (Test Mode DTC)
DESCRIPTION
The tire pressure warning valve and transmitter constantly sends radio waves to the tire pressure warning
ECU.
Under the following conditions, the tire pressure warning antenna and receiver is unable to receive the
signals from the tire pressure warning valve and transmitter, and a DTC is output.
• Areas, facilities, or devices that use similar radio frequencies are located in the vicinity of the vehicle.
• Devices using similar radio frequencies are used in the vehicle.
DTCs C2121/21 to C2124/24 can only be deleted by the tester. DTCs C2181/81 to C2184/84 can be
deleted when the transmitter sends a forced transmission signal or the test mode ends. DTCs C2181/81
to C2184/84 are output only in the test mode.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C2121/21
C2122/22
C2123/23
C2124/24
These DTCs are detected when no signals
are received for 51 minutes or more, after a
vehicle speed of 5 mph (8 km/h) or more is
detected and no signals are received for 12
minutes or more
•
Malfunction in transmission / reception circuit
•
C2181/81
C2182/82
C2183/83
C2184/84
•
•
•
•
•
•
Tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter
Tire pressure warning antenna and
receiver
Tire pressure warning ECU
Wire harness
Tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter
Tire pressure warning antenna and
receiver
Tire pressure warning ECU
Wire harness
HINT:
When no signals are received for 60 minutes or more, a DTC is output.
It is necessary to perform the procedure to identify the tire pressure warning valve and transmitter that is
malfunctioning because it cannot be identified by the output DTC.
TW
TW–40
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Tire Pressure Warning ECU
Tire Pressure Warning Antenna and Receiver
+5V
RF5V
RDA
RDA
GND
GND2
E118453E14
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
It is necessary to register an ID code after replacing the tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter and/or the tire pressure warning ECU (see page TW-14).
1
IDENTIFY TRANSMITTER (CORRESPONDING TO DTC)
(a) Set the pressure of each tire to the specified value.
Standard pressure
Front
Rear
240 kPa (2.4 kgf/cm2, 35 psi)
230 kPa (2.3 kgf/cm2, 33 psi)
(b) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Select TIREPRESS by following the prompts displayed
on the intelligent tester.
TW
Tire pressure warning ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
TIREPRESS1
ID1 tire pressure/ minimum: 0
Actual tire pressure
-
Actual tire pressure
-
kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi)
maximum: 637.5 kPa (6.5 kgf/
cm2, 92.5 psi)
TIREPRESS2
ID2 tire pressure/ minimum: 0
kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi)
maximum: 637.5 kPa (6.5 kgf/
cm2, 92.5 psi)
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
TIREPRESS3
ID3 tire pressure/ minimum: 0
Actual tire pressure
-
Actual tire pressure
-
TW–41
kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi)
maximum: 637.5 kPa (6.5 kgf/
cm2, 92.5 psi)
TIREPRESS4
ID4 tire pressure/ minimum: 0
kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi)
maximum: 637.5 kPa (6.5 kgf/
cm2, 92.5 psi)
(e) Rapidly release the tire pressure from any tire by 40 kPa
(0.4 kgf/cm2, 5.8 psi) for 30 seconds or more.
HINT:
• Identify the malfunctioning tire pressure warning valve
and transmitter by rapidly releasing the tire pressures
from each tire.
• Record which TIREPRESS data (ID1 to ID5)
corresponds to each tire.
(f) Check the DATA LIST.
Result
Condition
Detection Condition
One of TIREPRESS data (ID1 to ID4) changed
Normal
No TIREPRESS data changed
Transmitter corresponding to DTC
NOTICE:
• It may take up to 1 minute to display the updated
tire pressure data.
• When the TIREPRESS data (IDs 1 to 4) changes,
reset the tire pressure of the tires to the specified
value, rotate the tires 90 to 270° and recheck.
• When the transmitter is normal, record the tire
location and the transmitter ID.
(g) When the TIREPRESS data (IDs 1 to 4) changes, repeat
the same procedure on the rest of the tires (one by one)
to identify which tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter the DTC corresponds to.
(h) Set the pressure of each tire to the specified value.
Standard pressure
Front
Rear
240 kPa (2.4 kgf/cm
(i)
2,
35 psi)
230 kPa (2.3 kgf/cm2, 33 psi)
Check all transmitters of the tires.
Result
Result
Detection Condition
One or more of transmitters
abnormal
A
All abnormal
B
All normal
C
B
C
Go to step 3
END
TW
TW–42
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
A
2
CHECK TIRE PRESSURE WARNING VALVE AND TRANSMITTER
(a) Select REGIT ID CODE by following the prompts
displayed on the intelligent tester.
Tire pressure warning ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
REGIT ID1 CODE
Registered ID1 code/ minimum:
0 maximum: FFFFFFF
The ID No. registered in
transmitter ID1 is display
-
REGIT ID2 CODE
Registered ID2 code/ minimum:
0 maximum: FFFFFFF
The ID No. registered in
transmitter ID2 is display
-
REGIT ID3 CODE
Registered ID3 code/ minimum:
0 maximum: FFFFFFF
The ID No. registered in
transmitter ID3 is display
-
REGIT ID4 CODE
Registered ID4 code/ minimum:
0 maximum: FFFFFFF
The ID No. registered in
transmitter ID4 is display
-
Transmitter ID
(b) Remove the tire pressure warning valve and transmitter
and check its ID number (see page TW-72).
(c) Check whether the recorded transmitter ID and the
actual transmitter ID match.
Result
Result
Detection Condition
Unmatched
A
Matched
B
F100616E01
B
A
PERFORM REGISTRATION (TRANSMITTER ID)
TW
REPLACE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING
VALVE AND TRANSMITTER
TW–43
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ECU - RECEIVER)
Wire Harness Side
Tire Pressure Warning Antenna and Receiver
Tire Pressure Warning ECU
T11
1 (RDA)
T10
4 (GND2)
9 (RDA)
4 (GND)
5 (+5V)
10 (RF5V)
B128075E03
(a) Disconnect the T11 ECU connector.
(b) Disconnect the T10 receiver connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T11-10 (RF5V) - T10-5 (+5V)
Below 1 Ω
T11-9 (RDA) - T10-1 (RDA)
T11-4 (GND2) - T10-4 (GND)
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
4
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (TIRE PRESSURE)
(a) Check the DATA LIST tire pressure valve.
Tire pressure warning ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
TIREPRESS1
ID1 tire pressure/ minimum: 0
Actual tire pressure
-
Actual tire pressure
-
Actual tire pressure
-
kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi)
maximum: 637.5 kPa (6.5 kgf/
cm2, 92.5 psi)
TIREPRESS2
ID2 tire pressure/ minimum: 0
kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi)
maximum: 637.5 kPa (6.5 kgf/
cm2, 92.5 psi)
TIREPRESS3
ID3 tire pressure/ minimum: 0
kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi)
maximum: 637.5 kPa (6.5 kgf/
cm2, 92.5 psi)
TW
TW–44
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
TIREPRESS4
ID4 tire pressure/ minimum: 0
Actual tire pressure
-
kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi)
maximum: 637.5 kPa (6.5 kgf/
cm2, 92.5 psi)
OK:
All tire pressure readings are equal to the actual
tire pressure.
NOTICE:
It may take up to 1 minute to display the updated tire
pressure data.
OK
END
NG
5
CHECK ID CODE (TIRE PRESSURE WARNING VALVE AND TRANSMITTER)
(a) Select REGIT ID CODE by following the prompts
displayed on the intelligent tester.
Tire pressure warning ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
REGIT ID1 CODE
Registered ID1 code/ minimum:
0 maximum: FFFFFFF
The ID No. registered in
transmitter ID1 is display
-
REGIT ID2 CODE
Registered ID2 code/ minimum:
0 maximum: FFFFFFF
The ID No. registered in
transmitter ID2 is display
-
REGIT ID3 CODE
Registered ID3 code/ minimum:
0 maximum: FFFFFFF
The ID No. registered in
transmitter ID3 is display
-
REGIT ID4 CODE
Registered ID4 code/ minimum:
0 maximum: FFFFFFF
The ID No. registered in
transmitter ID4 is display
-
Transmitter ID
TW
(b) Remove the tire pressure monitor valve and check its ID
number (see page TW-72).
(c) Check whether the recorded transmitter ID and the
actual transmitter ID match.
Result
Result
Detection Condition
Unmatched
A
Matched
B
F100616E01
B
A
PERFORM REGISTRATION (TRANSMITTER ID)
REPLACE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING
RECEIVER AND TRANSMITTER
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
DTC
C2141/41 Transmitter ID1 Error
DTC
C2142/42 Transmitter ID2 Error
DTC
C2143/43 Transmitter ID3 Error
DTC
C2144/44 Transmitter ID4 Error
TW–45
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C2141/41
C2142/42
C2143/43
C2144/44
If an "ERROR" signal is received 3 times
consecutively, tire pressure monitor valve will
be judged as defective and this DTC will be
output.
This will happen in situations where inflation
pressure is outside range 0 to 537.5 kPa (0 to
Tire pressure warning valve and transmitter
5.27 kgf/cm2, 0 psi to 77.7 psi), temperature
inside tire is outside specified range -40 to
215°C (-40 to 419 °F), or an error occurs in
tire pressure monitor valve.
HINT:
It is necessary to perform the procedure to identify the tire pressure monitor valve that is malfunctioning
because it cannot be identified by the output DTC.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
It is necessary to register an ID code after replacing the tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter and/or the tire pressure warning ECU (see page TW-14).
1
IDENTIFY TRANSMITTER (CORRESPONDING TO DTC)
(a) Set the pressure of each tire to the specified value.
Standard pressure
Front
Rear
240 kPa (2.4
kgf/cm2,
35 psi)
230 kPa (2.3 kgf/cm2, 33 psi)
(b) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Select TIREPRESS by following the prompts displayed
on the intelligent tester.
Tire pressure warning ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
TIREPRESS1
ID1 tire pressure/ minimum: 0
Actual tire pressure
-
Actual tire pressure
-
kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi)
maximum: 637.5 kPa (6.5 kgf/
cm2, 92.5 psi)
TIREPRESS2
ID2 tire pressure/ minimum: 0
kgf/cm2,
0 psi)
kPa (0
maximum: 637.5 kPa (6.5 kgf/
cm2, 92.5 psi)
TW
TW–46
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
Item
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
TIREPRESS3
ID3 tire pressure/ minimum: 0
Actual tire pressure
-
Actual tire pressure
-
kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi)
maximum: 637.5 kPa (6.5 kgf/
cm2, 92.5 psi)
TIREPRESS4
ID4 tire pressure/ minimum: 0
kPa (0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi)
maximum: 637.5 kPa (6.5 kgf/
cm2, 92.5 psi)
NOTICE:
It may take up to 1 minute to display the updated
data.
(e) Rapidly release the tire pressure from any tire by 40 kPa
(0.4 kgf/cm2, 5.8 psi) for 30 seconds or more.
HINT:
• Identify the malfunctioning tire pressure warning valve
and transmitter by rapidly releasing the tire pressures
from each tire.
• Record which TIREPRESS data (ID1 to ID4)
corresponds to each tire.
(f) Check the DATA LIST.
Result
Condition
Detection Condition
One of TIREPRESS data (ID1 to ID4) changed
Normal
None of TIREPRESS data changed
Transmitter corresponding to DTC
NOTICE:
• When the TIREPRESS data (IDs 1 to 4) changes,
reset the tire pressure of the tires to the specified
value, rotate the tires 90 to 270° and recheck.
• When the transmitter is normal, record the tire
location and the transmitter ID.
(g) When one of the TIREPRESS data (IDs 1 to 4) changes,
repeat the same procedure on the rest of the tires one by
one to identify which tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter the DTC corresponds to.
(h) When the TIREPRESS data (IDs 1 to 4) has been
changed, identify the malfunctioning tire pressure
warning valve and transmitter by using recorded ID
numbers and the output DTC.
(i) Set the pressure of each tire to the specified value.
Standard pressure
TW
Front
240 kPa (2.4
Rear
kgf/cm2
, 35 psi)
NEXT
REPLACE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING VALVE AND TRANSMITTER
230 kPa (2.3 kgf/cm2, 33 psi)
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
DTC
C2165/65 Abnormal Temperature Inside ID1 Tire
DTC
C2166/66 Abnormal Temperature Inside ID2 Tire
DTC
C2167/67 Abnormal Temperature Inside ID3 Tire
DTC
C2168/68 Abnormal Temperature Inside ID4 Tire
TW–47
DESCRIPTION
The tire pressure warning valve and transmitter measures tire internal temperature as well as tire
pressure, and transmits the information to the tire pressure monitor receiver along with the transmitter ID.
If the measured temperature is out of the specified range, the tire pressure warning ECU recognizes it as
a malfunction, outputs DTCs, and blinks the tire pressure warning light.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C2165/65
C2166/66
C2167/67
C2168/68
Tire internal temperature is not within -40 to
120°C (-40 to 246°F)
•
•
Tire
Tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter
HINT:
It is necessary to perform the procedure to identify the tire pressure warning valve and transmitter that is
malfunctioning because it cannot be identified by the output DTC.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
It is necessary to register an ID code after replacing the tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter and/or the tire pressure warning ECU (see page TW-14).
1
IDENTIFY TRANSMITTER (CORRESPONDING TO DTC)
(a) Set the pressure of each tire to the specified value.
Standard pressure
Front
Rear
2
240 kPa (2.4 kgf/cm , 35 psi)
230 kPa (2.3 kgf/cm2, 33 psi)
(b) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(c) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(d) Select TIREPRESS by following the prompts displayed
on the intelligent tester.
Tire pressure warning ECU
Item
Measurement item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
TIREPRESS1
ID1 tire pressure / min.: 0 kPa
Actual tire pressure
-
Actual tire pressure
-
Actual tire pressure
-
(0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi), max.: 637.5
kPa (6.48 kgf/cm2, 92.2 psi)
TIREPRESS2
ID2 tire pressure / min.: 0 kPa
(0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi), max.: 637.5
kPa (6.48 kgf/cm2, 92.2 psi)
TIREPRESS3
ID3 tire pressure / min.: 0 kPa
(0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi), max.: 637.5
kPa (6.48 kgf/cm2, 92.2 psi)
TW
TW–48
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
Item
Measurement item / Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
TIREPRESS4
ID4 tire pressure / min.: 0 kPa
Actual tire pressure
-
(0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi), max.: 637.5
kPa (6.48 kgf/cm2, 92.2 psi)
(e) Rapidly release the tire pressure from any tire by 40 kPa
(0.4 kgf/cm2, 5.8 psi) for 30 seconds or more.
HINT:
• Identify the malfunctioning tire pressure warning valve
and transmitter by rapidly releasing the tire pressures
from each tire.
• Record which TIREPRESS data (ID1 to ID4)
corresponds to each tire.
(f) Check the DATA LIST.
Result
Condition
Detection Condition
One of TIREPRESS data (ID1 to ID4) changed
Normal
No TIREPRESS data changed
Transmitter corresponding to DTC
NOTICE:
• It may take up to 1 minute to display the updated data.
• When the TIREPRESS data (IDs 1 to 4) changes, reset
the tire pressure of the tires to the specified value,
rotate the tires 90 to 270° and recheck.
• When the transmitter is normal, record the tire
location and the transmitter ID.
(g) When one of the TIREPRESS data (IDs 1 to 4) changes,
repeat the same procedure on the rest of the tires (one
by one) to identify which tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter the DTC corresponds to.
(h) When the TIREPRESS data (IDs 1 to 4) has been
changed, identify the malfunctioning tire pressure
warning valve and transmitter by using recorded ID
numbers and output DTC.
(i) Set the pressure of each tire to the specified value.
Standard pressure
Front
Rear
2
240 kPa (2.4 kgf/cm , 35 psi)
TW
230 kPa (2.3 kgf/cm2, 33 psi)
NEXT
2
CHECK TIRE
(a) Check that the tire is not punctured, and there is no
indication of air pressure drop.
OK:
Tire is normal.
NG
REPLACE TIRE
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
TW–49
OK
REPLACE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING VALVE AND TRANSMITTER
TW
TW–50
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
DTC
C2171/71 Transmitter ID not Registered in Main Mode
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C2171/71
Transmitter ID code is not registered (when
an ID code is unregistered for 51 minutes or
more)
Tire pressure warning ECU
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
It is necessary to register an ID code after replacing the tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter and/or the tire pressure monitor ECU (see page TW-14).
HINT:
Set the tire pressure to the specified value.
Standard pressure
Front
Rear
240 kPa (2.4
1
kgf/cm2,
230 kPa (2.3 kgf/cm2, 33 psi)
35 psi)
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (REGISTERED ID CODES)
(a) Check the DATA LIST for proper functioning of the
registered ID codes.
Tire pressure warning ECU
Item
Measurement item/ Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
REGIT ID1 CODE
Registered ID1 code / min.: 0,
max.: FFFFFFF
The ID No. registered in the
transmitter ID1 is displayed
-
REGIT ID2 CODE
Registered ID2 code / min.: 0,
max.: FFFFFFF
The ID No. registered in the
transmitter ID2 is displayed
-
REGIT ID3 CODE
Registered ID3 code / min.: 0,
max.: FFFFFFF
The ID No. registered in the
transmitter ID3 is displayed
-
REGIT ID4 CODE
Registered ID4 code / min.: 0,
max.: FFFFFFF
The ID No. registered in the
transmitter ID4 is displayed
-
OK:
The registered transmitter ID codes are displayed
on the intelligent tester screen.
OK
TW
REPLACE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU
NG
2
PERFORM REGISTRATION (TRANSMITTER ID)
(a) Register the transmitter IDs for all the wheels (see page
TW-14).
(b) Set the pressure of each tire to the specified value.
Standard pressure
Front
Rear
2
240 kPa (2.4 kgf/cm , 35 psi)
230 kPa (2.3 kgf/cm2, 33 psi)
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
TW–51
NEXT
3
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (TIRE PRESSURE)
(a) Check the DATA LIST tire pressure value.
Tire pressure warning ECU
Item
Measurement item/ Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
TIREPRESS1
ID1 tire pressure / min.: 0 kPa
Actual tire pressure
-
Actual tire pressure
-
Actual tire pressure
-
Actual tire pressure
-
(0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi), max.: 637.5
kPa (6.48 kgf/cm2, 92.2 psi)
TIREPRESS2
ID3 tire pressure / min.: 0 kPa
(0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi), max.: 637.5
kPa (6.48 kgf/cm2, 92.2 psi)
TIREPRESS3
ID3 tire pressure / min.: 0 kPa
(0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi), max.: 637.5
kPa (6.48 kgf/cm2, 92.2 psi)
TIREPRESS4
ID4 tire pressure / min.: 0 kPa
(0 kgf/cm2, 0 psi), max.: 637.5
kPa (6.48 kgf/cm2, 92.2 psi)
OK:
All tire pressure readings are equal to the actual
tire pressure.
NOTICE:
It may take up to 1 minute to display the tire pressure
data.
NG
REPLACE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU
OK
END
TW
TW–52
DTC
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
C2176/76 Receiver Error
DESCRIPTION
DTC No.
C2176/76
DTC Detection Condition
DTC is stored when either of following is detected:
• Malfunction in tire pressure warning ECU internal
circuit.
• Terminal RF5V is shorted to ground.
Trouble Area
•
•
•
Tire pressure warning antenna and receiver
Tire pressure warning ECU
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
Tire Pressure Warning Antenna and Receiver
Tire Pressure Warning ECU
+5V
RF5V
RDA
RDA
GND
GND2
E118453E14
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
TW
NOTICE:
It is necessary to register an ID code after replacing the tire pressure warning valve abd
transmitter and/or the tire pressure warning ECU (see page TW-14).
HINT:
Set the tire pressure to the specified value.
Standard pressure
Front
Rear
240 kPa (2.4 kgf/cm2, 35 psi)
230 kPa (2.3 kgf/cm2, 33 psi)
TW–53
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
1
CHECK TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ANTENNA AND RECEIVER
(a) Measure the voltage of the connector.
Standard voltage
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
T10-5 (+5V) - T10-4
(GND)
Power switch ON (IG)
4.5 to 5.5 V
NG
+5V
Go to step 5
GND
E113554E05
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ECU - RECEIVER)
(a) Disconnect the T11 ECU connector.
(b) Disconnect the T10 receiver connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Wire Harness Side
Tire Pressure Warning Antenna and Receiver
Tire Pressure Warning ECU
1 (RDA)
T10
T11
9 (RDA)
B128075E04
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T11-9 (RDA) - T10-1 (RDA)
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
OK
3
NEXT
REPLACE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ANTENNA AND RECEIVER
TW
TW–54
4
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
CHECK DTC
(a) Check for DTC (see page TW-27).
OK:
DTC is not output.
HINT:
• It is necessary to register an ID when replacing the
tire pressure warning ECU (see page TW-14).
• Read the ID on the DATA LIST before removing the
tire pressure warning ECU. Register the ID in the new
tire pressure warning ECU.
NG
REPLACE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU
OK
END
5
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ECU - RECEIVER)
(a) Disconnect the T11 ECU connector.
(b) Disconnect the T10 receiver connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Wire Harness Side
Tire Pressure Warning Antenna and Receiver
Tire Pressure Warning ECU
T11
T10
4 (GND2)
TW
4 (GND)
5 (+5V)
10 (RF5V)
B128075E05
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T11-4 (GND2) - T10-4 (GND)
Below 1 Ω
T11-10 (RF5V) - T10-5 (+5V)
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
TW–55
OK
REPLACE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU
TW
TW–56
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
DTC
C2177/77 Initialization not Completed
DESCRIPTION
The initialization procedure starts when the tire pressure warning reset switch is pressed for 3 seconds or
more with the power switch in the ON (IG) position.
The tire pressure warning ECU registers the tire pressure data signals from the tire pressure warning
valve and transmitter, and blinks the tire pressure warning light 3 times at 1 second intervals.
DTC No.
DTC Detection Condition
Trouble Area
C2177/77
Initialization not complete after vehicle driven
at 5 mph (8 km/h) or more for total of 20
minutes or more.
•
•
Tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter
Tire pressure warning ECU
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
• When replacing the tire pressure warning ECU, read the IDs stored in the ECU using the
intelligent tester and note them down before removal (see page TW-28).
• It is necessary to perform initialization (see page TW-17) after registration (see page TW-14) the
transmitter IDs into the tire pressure warning ECU after the tire pressure warning ECU and/ or
tire pressure warning valve and transmitter have been replaced.
1
CHECK DTC
(a) Check for DTCs (see page TW-27).
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC C2177 output with another
DTCs
A
Only DTC C2177 output
B
HINT:
• When the tire pressure warning ECU receives no
signals for several minutes after the initialization
procedure has finished, a DTC is output.
• When only DTC C2177 is output, refer to the other
troubleshooting procedure (see page TW-35).
B
TW
GO TO OTHER PROBLEM (MALFUNCTION
IN TRANSMISSION OR RECEPTION)
A
INSPECTION PROCEDURE RELEVANT TO OUTPUT DTC
TW–57
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
DTC
C2191/91 Vehicle Speed Signal Error (Test Mode DTC)
DESCRIPTION
The tire pressure monitor ECU receives speed signals from the combination meter. This DTC is stored
upon entering the test mode, and cleared when a vehicle speed signal of 20 km/h (12 mph) is detected for
3 seconds or more. The DTC is output only in the test mode.
DTC No.
DTC Detecting Condition
C2191/91
Trouble Area
•
•
•
•
Speed sensor circuit malfunction.
Combination meter
MPX communication system
Tire pressure warning ECU
Wire harness
WIRING DIAGRAM
Gateway ECU
Tire Pressure Warning ECU
Combination Meter
MPD1
MPX-
MPX+
MPX2
MPD2
MPX1
C128027E05
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
• When replacing the tire pressure warning ECU, read the IDs stored in the ECU using the
intelligent tester and note them down before removal.
• It is necessary to perform initialization (see page TW-17) after registration (see page TW-14) of
the transmitter IDs into the tire pressure warning ECU after the ECU or valve and transmitter
has been replaced.
TW
TW–58
1
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
CHECK DTC
(a) Check for DTCs of the MPX communication and the
speed sensor.
Result
Condition
Proceed to
MPX communication error DTC is output.
A (See page MP-16)
DTC of the vehicle speed sensor (C0200/31,C0205/32, C0210/33
and C0215/34) is output.
B (See page BC-54, BC-61)
DTCs of the MPX communication and the speed sensor are not
output.
C
A
REPAIR CIRCUITS INDICATED BY OUTPUT
DTCS
B
REPAIR CIRCUITS INDICATED BY OUTPUT
DTCS
C
2
READ VALUE OF INTELLIGENT TESTER
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch to the ON (IG) position, and turn
the intelligent tester on.
(c) Select the item below in the DATA LIST, and read the
value displayed on the intelligent tester.
Tire pressure warning ECU
Item
VEHICLE SPEED
Measurement Item / Range
(Display)
Vehicle speed reading/
min.: 0 km/h (0 mph)
max.: 255 km/h (158 mph)
Normal Condition
Almost same as actual vehicle
speed
Diagnostic Note
Speed indicated on the
combination meter
(d) Check that the value indicated on the tester and on the
combination meter are the same.
OK:
Vehicle speed indicated on the intelligent tester
indicates the actual speed.
TW
OK
NG
REPLACE COMBINATION METER
REPLACE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU
TW–59
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
Tire Pressure Warning Reset Switch Circuit
DESCRIPTION
During initialization, the tire pressure warning ECU receives the signal from the tire pressure warning
reset switch. If the initialization is completely normally, the tire pressure warning light blinks 3 times (1
second on, 1 second off).
WIRING DIAGRAM
Tire Pressure Warning ECU
Tire Pressure Warning
Reset Switch
CLSW
GND
F100645E10
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
It is necessary to register an ID code after replacing the tire pressure warning valve and
transmitter and / or the tire pressure warning ECU (see page TW-14).
1
CHECK TIRE PRESSURE WARNING RESET SWITCH FUNCTION
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Check that the tire pressure warning light comes on for 3
seconds.
TW
TW–60
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
(c) Perform the tire pressure warning reset switch test in
TEST MODE PROCEDURE (see page TW-19).
OK:
Reset switch ON:
Tire pressure warning light comes on.
Reset switch OFF:
Tire pressure warning light blinks.
OK
PROCEED TO NEXT CIRCUIT INSPECTION
SHOWN IN PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
NG
2
INSPECT TIRE PRESSURE WARNING RESET SWITCH
Tire Pressure Warning Reset Switch
(a) Remove the tire pressure warning reset switch.
(b) Measure the resistance of the switch.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
ON
2
1
OFF
C107260E05
OK
TW
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
ON
Below 1 Ω
1-2
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPLACE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING
RESET SWITCH
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
3
TW–61
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (RESET SWITCH - TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU)
Wire Harness Side
Tire Pressure Warning Reset Switch
T12
(a) Disconnect the T12 tire pressure warning reset switch
connector and T11 tire pressure warning ECU connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T11-2 (CLSW) - T12-1
Below 1 Ω
T11-2 (CLSW) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
Tire Pressure Warning ECU
T11
2 (CLSW)
C111010E05
OK
REPLACE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU
TW
TW–62
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
Tire Pressure Warning Light Circuit
DESCRIPTION
When the tire pressure decreases, the ECU sends the communication signal to the combination meter
assembly through the BEAN, and it illuminates the tire pressure warning light on the combination meter
assembly.
The tire pressure warning light also turns on when the signal for the tire pressure warning light is cut off.
HINT:
Refer to the "TIRE PRESSURE WARNING LIGHT CHART" section of the "DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM" for
checking the condition of the tire pressure warning light (see page TW-24).
WIRING DIAGRAM
Gateway ECU
Tire Pressure Warning ECU
Combination Meter
MPD1
MPX-
MPX+
MPX2
MPD2
MPX1
C128027E01
TW
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
NOTICE:
It is necessary to perform initialization (see page TW-17) after registration (see page TW-14) of the
transmitter IDs into the tire pressure warning ECU after the ECU or valve and transmitter has been
replaced.
HINT:
This procedure must be performed according to the PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE.
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
1
TW–63
CHECK DIAGNOSTIC CODE OUTPUT
(a) Check if DTC B1247 is output in the multiplex
communication system (See page MP-41).
Result
Result
Proceed to
B1247 is not output
A
B1247 is output
B
B
REPAIR CIRCUIT INDICATED BY OUTPUT
CODE
A
2
PERFORM ACTIVE TEST BY INTELLIGENT TESTER (TIRE PRESSURE WARNING LIGHT)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and press the intelligent
tester main switch on.
(c) Select the ACTIVE TEST mode on the intelligent tester.
(d) Check the condition of the tire pressure warning light by
operating the tester.
Combination meter
Item
Vehicle Condition / Test Details
Diagnostic Note
TIRE PRESS WARN
Tire pressure warning light / ON or OFF
ON: light turns on
OFF: light turns off
OK:
The warning light turns on when operating the
tester.
NG
REPLACE COMBINATION METER
ASSEMBLY
OK
REPLACE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU
TW
TW–64
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
ECU Power Source Circuit
DESCRIPTION
This is the power source for the tire pressure warning ECU. It also supplies the power to the tire pressure
warning antenna and receiver via the ECU.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Tire Pressure Warning ECU
ECU-IG
IG
IG1D
IG1
AM1
Power Source Control ECU
GND
B128079E01
TW
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT FUSE (ECU-IG)
(a) Remove the ECU-IG fuse from the driver side junction
block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the fuse.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
NG
TW–65
CHECK FOR SHORT IN ALL HARNESSES
AND CONNECTORS CONNECTED TO FUSE
AND REPLACE FUSE
OK
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU - BATTERY)
(a) Disconnect the T11 tire pressure warning ECU
connector.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
T11
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T11-1 (IG) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
NG
1 (IG)
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
C110949E17
OK
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU - BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the T11 tire pressure warning ECU
connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
T11
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
T11-7 (GND) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
7 (GND)
C110949E18
OK
REPLACE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
TW
TW–66
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
TC and CG Terminal Circuit
DESCRIPTION
DTC output mode is set by connecting terminals TC and CG of the DLC3.
The DTCs are displayed by blinking the tire pressure warning light.
TW
TW–67
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
WIRING DIAGRAM
Tire Pressure Warning ECU
Combination Meter
MPX2
MPX+
MPX-
Power Source Control ECU
Gateway ECU
MPD2
MPX1
MPX2
MPX1
MPD1
CA1H
ECM
CANH
CA1L
CANL
TC
DLC3
TW
TC
CANH
CANL
CG
B128089E01
TW–68
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK CAN COMMUNICATION SYSTEM AND MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION SYSTEM
(a) Check if a DTC of CAN communication system and
multiplex communication system is output.
Result
Result
Proceed to
DTC is not output
A
DTC is output
B
B
REPAIR CIRCUITS INDICATED BY OUTPUT
DTCS
A
2
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (ECM - DLC3)
(a) Disconnect the E6 ECM connector.
(b) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connector.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
ECM
E6
DLC3
D1
TC
B128090E01
OK
Specified Condition
E6-14 (TC) - D1-13 (TC)
Below 1 Ω
D1-13 (TC) - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
TC
TW
Tester Connection
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
3
TW–69
INSPECT DLC3 TERMINAL VOLTAGE
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Measure the voltage of the DLC3 connector.
Standard voltage
D1
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D1-13 (TC) - Body ground
10 to 14 V
NG
REPLACE ECM
TC
H100769E70
OK
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (DLC3 - BODY GROUND)
(a) Measure the resistance of the DLC3 connector.
Standard resistance
D1
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D1-4 (CG) - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
CG
H100769E71
OK
REPLACE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU
TW
TW–66
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING RECEIVER
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING RECEIVER
SUSPENSION
TIRE
AND WHEEL
& AXLE
COMPONENTS
ROOF SIDE INNER GARNISH ASSEMBLY RH
CONNECTOR
REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP RH
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING
RECEIVER ASSEMBLY
TW
42 (430, 31)
DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY RH
REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH
REAR SEAT 3 POINT TYPE BELT ASSEMBLY RH
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C128499E01
TW–67
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING RECEIVER
BACK DOOR WEATHERSTRIP
TONNEAU COVER ASSEMBLY
DECK TRIM COVER REAR
REAR FLOOR NO. 3 BOARD
ROPE HOOK
REAR FLOOR NO. 1 BOARD
REAR FLOOR NO. 2 BOARD
REAR FLOOR
NO. 4 BOARD
REAR SIDE
SEATBACK FRAME RH
DECK FLOOR BOX LH
TW
DECK FLOOR BOX REAR
REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY
REAR SIDE SEATBACK FRAME LH
C128500E01
TW–68
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING RECEIVER
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY (See
page SE-15)
3.
REMOVE REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH (See page
IR-9)
4.
REMOVE REAR SIDE SEATBACK FRAME LH (See
page IR-9)
5.
REMOVE REAR SIDE SEATBACK FRAME RH (See
page IR-9)
6.
REMOVE REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP RH
7.
REMOVE REAR SEAT 3 POINT TYPE BELT
ASSEMBLY RH (See page IR-10)
8.
REMOVE BACK DOOR WEATHERSTRIP
9.
REMOVE TONNEAU COVER ASSEMBLY
10. REMOVE REAR FLOOR NO. 2 BOARD
11. REMOVE REAR FLOOR NO. 3 BOARD
12. REMOVE REAR FLOOR NO. 4 BOARD
13. REMOVE DECK FLOOR BOX REAR
14. REMOVE DECK FLOOR BOX LH
15. REMOVE REAR FLOOR NO. 1 BOARD (See page IR10)
16. REMOVE DECK TRIM COVER REAR (See page IR-10)
17. REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY RH
(See page IR-11)
18. REMOVE ROOF SIDE INNER GARNISH ASSEMBLY
RH (See page IR-11)
TW
19. REMOVE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING RECEIVER
ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the bolt.
(c) Using a clip remover, detach the clip and remove
the receiver.
Clip
Connector
C128501E01
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING RECEIVER
TW–69
INSTALLATION
Clip
1.
INSTALL TIRE PRESSURE WARNING RECEIVER
ASSEMBLY
(a) Attach the clip and install the bolt with the receiver.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (76 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
(b) Connect the connector.
2.
INSTALL ROOF SIDE INNER GARNISH ASSEMBLY
RH (See page IR-15)
3.
INSTALL DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY RH
(See page IR-16)
4.
INSTALL REAR DECK TRIM COVER (See page IR-16)
5.
INSTALL REAR FLOOR NO. 1 BOARD (See page IR16)
6.
INSTALL DECK FLOOR BOX LH
7.
INSTALL DECK FLOOR BOX REAR
8.
INSTALL REAR FLOOR NO. 4 BOARD
9.
INSTALL REAR FLOOR NO. 3 BOARD
Connector
C128501E01
10. INSTALL REAR FLOOR NO. 2 BOARD
11. INSTALL TONNEAU COVER ASSEMBLY
12. INSTALL BACK DOOR WEATHERSTRIP
13. INSTALL REAR SEAT 3 POINT TYPE BELT
ASSEMBLY RH (See page IR-16)
14. INSTALL REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP RH
15. INSTALL REAR SIDE SEATBACK FRAME LH (See
page IR-17)
16. INSTALL REAR SIDE SEATBACK FRAME RH (See
page IR-17)
17. INSTALL REAR DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH (See page
IR-19)
18. INSTALL REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY (See
page SE-23)
19. CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
NOTICE:
• When the warning light is illuminated or the
battery has been disconnected and reconnected,
pressing the power switch may not start the
system on the first try. If so, press the power
switch again.
• With the power switch's power mode changed to
ON (IG), disconnect the battery. If the key is not in
the key slot during reconnection, DTC B2799 may
be output.
TW
TW–70
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING RECEIVER
20. REGISTER TRANSMITTER ID
(a) Register the transmitter ID (see page TW-14).
21. INSPECT TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
(a) Inspect the tire pressure warning system (see page
TW-22).
22. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page TW-17).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
TW
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING VALVE AND TRANSMITTER
TW–71
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING VALVE AND TRANSMITTER
SUSPENSION
TIRE
AND WHEEL
& AXLE
COMPONENTS
INNER GROMMET
WASHER
4.0 (41, 35 in.*lbf)
NUT
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING
VALVE SUB-ASSEMBLY
VALVE CORE
TW
CAP
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C128502E01
TW–72
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING VALVE AND TRANSMITTER
REMOVAL
Tire
1.
REMOVE FRONT WHEEL
2.
REMOVE REAR WHEEL
3.
REMOVE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING VALVE SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the valve core and cap, and release air
from the tire.
(b) After ensuring that air is sufficiently released,
remove the nut and washer that are used to fix the
tire pressure warning valve and drop the valve
sensor inside the tire.
HINT:
Keep the removed cap, valve core, nut and washer.
(c) After dropping the tire pressure warning valve into
the tire, disengage the bead using the shoe of the
tire remover.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the tire pressure
warning valve because of interference between
the sensor and tire bead.
(d) Remove the bead on the upper side.
(e) Take out the valve sensor from the tire and remove
the bead on the lower bead.
HINT:
Check that there are no cracks or damage on the
grommet. If any damage is found, replace the
grommet together with the washer and nut.
Shoe
10 to 20 mm
(0.39 to 0.79 in.)
C083779E01
INSTALLATION
Print Surface
C128503E01
TW
1.
INSTALL TIRE PRESSURE WARNING VALVE SUBASSEMBLY
(a) Insert the tire pressure warning valve into the valve
installation hole. Insert it from the inside of the rim
so that the print surface can be seen.
NOTICE:
• Check that there is no visible deformation,
damage or other abnormalities on the
transmitter.
• Check that there is no foreign matter on the
inner grommet and around the rim hole.
• If installed in the reverse direction, the tire
pressure warning valve may be damaged or
fail to transmit signals when running at high
speed.
• If installing a new tire pressure warning valve,
write down the ID number before installation.
• It is necessary to register the ID in the ECU
after installation (see page TW-14).
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING VALVE AND TRANSMITTER
(b) Set the washer on the tire pressure monitor valve
rim side. Tighten the tire pressure warning valve
with the nut.
Torque: 4.0 N*m (41 kgf*cm, 35 ft.*lbf)
NOTICE:
• Check that there is no foreign matter on the
washer and nut.
• If the tire pressure warning valve is removed
when the tire is removed for replacement,
check that there is no damage or cuts, and no
foreign matter such as mud, dirt or sand
attached to the grommet. Replace the
grommet with a new one if necessary.
• Check that there is no oil, water or lubricant
around the rim hole, tire pressure warning
valve, washer and nut. Failing to check may
result in improper installation.
(c) After the tire is inflated, the valve nut may be loose.
Retighten the nut to the specified torque and then
check for air leaks with soapy water.
Torque: 4.0 N*m (41 kgf*cm, 35 in.*lbf)
Grommet
Nut
Rim
Sensor
Cap
Washer
C128504E01
(d) Set the wheel disc to the mounting machine and
install the lower tire bead. Position the main body of
the valve sensor as in the shaded area shown in the
illustration.
NOTICE:
If the valve sensor is positioned outside this
area, it generates interference with the tire bead,
and may cause damage to the valve sensor.
(e) Install the upper bead.
NOTICE:
Make sure that the tire bead and tool do not
interfere with the main body of the valve sensor
and that the valve sensor is not clamped by the
bead.
Mount Tool of Mounting Machine
Rim
Rim Rotating
Direction
Area for Valve Sensor
Mount Tool of Mounting Machine
Rim
Rim Rotating
Direction
Area for Valve Sensor
TW–73
2.
INSTALL FRONT WHEEL
Torque: 131 N*m (1,340 kgf*cm, 97 ft.*lbf)
3.
INSTALL REAR WHEEL
Torque: 131 N*m (1,340 kgf*cm, 97 ft.*lbf)
4.
INSPECT TIRE
(a) Inspect the tire (see page TW-3).
5.
REGISTER TRANSMITTER ID
(a) Register the transmitter ID (see page TW-14).
6.
INSPECT TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
(a) Inspect the tire pressure warning system (see page
TW-22).
C084539E01
TW
TW–74
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING VALVE AND TRANSMITTER
DISPOSAL
HINT:
The tire pressure monitor valve is powered by a lithium
battery. When disposing of the tire pressure monitor valve,
remove the battery and dispose of it correctly.
1.
DISPOSE OF TIRE PRESSURE WARNING VALVE
SUB-ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a screwdriver, pry off the cover. Remove the
back cover.
C128511
Lithium Battery
Base Board
Terminal
C128512E01
TW
(b) The battery and base board covered with resin are
exposed. While taking out the battery, cut the 2
terminals which connect the battery and base
board.
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU
TW–75
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU
SUSPENSION
TIRE
AND WHEEL
& AXLE
COMPONENTS
MULTI-DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
NO. 3 INSTRUMENT PANEL
REGISTER ASSEMBLY
INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL
SUB-ASSEMBLY UPPER
NO. 2 INSTRUMENT PANEL
REGISTER ASSEMBLY
CONNECTOR
NO. 4 INSTRUMENT PANEL
REGISTER ASSEMBLY
7.5 (76, 66 in.*lbf)
NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL
REGISTER ASSEMBLY
TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU
TW
INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL SUB-ASSEMBLY LOWER
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
C128497E01
TW–76
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-5)
3.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL SUBASSEMBLY LOWER (See page IP-6)
4.
REMOVE INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL SUBASSEMBLY UPPER (See page IP-6)
5.
REMOVE NO.3 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-6)
6.
REMOVE NO.4 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-6)
7.
REMOVE NO.2 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-7)
8.
REMOVE MULTI-DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the multi-display (see page IP-7).
9.
REMOVE TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the bolt and ECU.
Connector
C128498E01
INSTALLATION
TW
Connector
C128498E01
1.
INSTALL TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU
(a) Install the ECU with the bolt.
Torque: 7.5 N*m (76 kgf*cm, 66 in.*lbf)
(b) Connect the connector.
2.
INSTALL MULTI-DISPLAY ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the multi-display (see page IP-12).
3.
INSTALL NO. 2 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-12)
4.
INSTALL NO. 4 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-12)
5.
INSTALL NO. 3 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-13)
6.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL SUBASSEMBLY UPPER (See page IP-13)
TIRE AND WHEEL – TIRE PRESSURE WARNING ECU
TW–77
7.
INSTALL INSTRUMENT PANEL FINISH PANEL SUBASSEMBLY LOWER (See page IP-13)
8.
INSTALL NO. 1 INSTRUMENT PANEL REGISTER
ASSEMBLY (See page IP-13)
9.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
NOTICE:
• When the warning light is illuminated or the
battery has been disconnected and reconnected,
pressing the power switch may not start the
system on the first try. If so, press the power
switch again.
• With the power switch's power mode changed to
ON (IG), disconnect the battery. If the key is not in
the key slot during reconnection, DTC B2799 may
be output.
10. REGISTER TRANSMITTER ID
(a) Register the transmitter ID (see page TW-14).
11. INSPECT TIRE PRESSURE WARNING SYSTEM
(a) Inspect the tire pressure warning system (see page
TW-22).
12. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
TW
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
WS–1
POWER WINDOW CONTROL
SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
NOTICE:
FOR INITIALIZATION:
When disconnecting the cable from the negative (-)
battery terminal, initialize the following system after the
cable is reconnected.
System Name
See Page
Power Window Control System
IN-32
FOR HYBRID SYSTEM ACTIVATION:
When the warning light is illuminated or the battery has
been disconnected and reconnected, pressing the power
switch may not start the system on the first try. If so,
press the power switch again.
WS
WS–2
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
HOW TO PROCEED WITH
TROUBLESHOOTING
HINT:
• Use this procedure to troubleshoot the power window
control system.
• *: Use the intelligent tester.
1
VEHICLE BROUGHT TO WORKSHOP
NEXT
2
INSPECT BATTERY VOLTAGE
Standard voltage:
11 to 14 V
If the voltage is below 11 V, recharge or replace the battery
before proceeding.
NEXT
3
CHECK COMMUNICATION FUNCTION OF LARGE-SCALE BODY MULTIPLEX
COMMUNICATION SYSTEM (BEAN)*
(a) Using the intelligent tester, check if the Multiplex
Communication System (MPX) is functioning normally.
Result
WS
Result
Proceed to
MPX DTC is not output
A
MPX DTC is output
B
B
Go to MULTIPLEX COMMUNICATION
SYSTEM
A
4
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
Result
Result
Proceed to
If the fault is not listed in the problem symptoms table
A
If the fault is listed in the problem symptoms table
B
B
Go to step 7
A
5
OVERALL ANALYSIS AND TROUBLESHOOTING*
(a) Terminals of ECU (see page WS-9)
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
WS–3
(b) DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST (see page WS-13)
(c) On-vehicle Inspection (see page WS-14)
(d) Inspection (see page WS-16)
NEXT
6
ADJUST, REPAIR OR REPLACE
NEXT
7
CONFIRMATION TEST
NEXT
8
RESET POWER WINDOW MOTOR
If the power window switch AUTO light is blinking, reset the
power window (see page WS-7).
NEXT
END
WS
WS–4
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
SWITCH ASSEMBLY FRONT RH
POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
ASSEMBLY FRONT LH
POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
MOTOR ASSEMBLY FRONT RH
POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
ASSEMBLY FRONT RH
POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
MOTOR ASSEMBLY FRONT LH
POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
MASTER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
WS
POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
SWITCH ASSEMBLY REAR RH
POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
MOTOR ASSEMBLY REAR RH
FRONT DOOR
COURTESY LIGHT
SWITCH ASSEMBLY
LH
POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
ASSEMBLY REAR RH
POWER WINDOW
REGULATOR MOTOR
ASSEMBLY REAR LH
FRONT DOOR COURTESY
LIGHT SWITCH ASSEMBLY RH
POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
ASSEMBLY REAR LH
POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
SWITCH ASSEMBLY REAR LH
E124620E01
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
WS–5
ENGINE ROOM JUNCTION BLOCK
- AM2 FUSE
CENTER CONNECTOR NO. 1
DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
- MAIN BODY ECU
- IG1 RELAY
- PWR RELAY
- PWR H-FUSE
- GAUGE FUSE
- FR DOOR FUSE
- ECU-IG FUSE
CENTER CONNECTOR
NO. 2
E130161E01
WS
WS–6
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
Front Door Courtesy
Light Switch LH
Driver Side Junction Block
Front Door Courtesy
Light Switch RH
PWR
Power Source
Control ECU
Power Switch
BEAN
Body ECU
Power Window Regulator
Motor Front LH
WS
M
Hall IC
Hall IC
Power Window
Regulator Master
Switch
Power Window
Regulator Switch
Front RH
Power Window
M Regulator Switch
Front RH
Power Window
Regulator Switch
Rear LH
Power Window
Regulator Switch
Rear RH
Power Window
M Regulator Motor
Rear LH
Power Window
M Regulator Motor
Rear RH
E124623E01
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
WS–7
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
2.
POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
DESCRIPTION
The power window control system controls the power
windows' UP / DOWN function using the regulator
motors.
The main controls of this system are: the power window
regulator master switch, which is built into the driver side
door, and the power window regulator switches, which
are built into the passenger side door and rear doors.
Pressing each regulator switch or any of the switches on
the master switch transmits an UP / DOWN signal to the
corresponding power window regulator motor.
The jammed window detection mechanism consists of a
magnet on the worm gear of the power window motor
and the Hall ICs on the connector.
FUNCTION OF MAIN COMPONENT
Component
Outline
Power Window Regulator Master Switch Assembly
Controls window operations for all windows. Also, when window lock
switch is set to lock position, window operation will only be possible for
driver side power window.
Power Window Regulator Switch Assembly
Located on passenger side door and rear doors. Each regulator
switch controls window operations for its respective window.
Power Window Regulator Motor Assembly
Receives switch signals and changes signals into motor activation. As
a result, window position changes. Also, driver side regulator motor
uses pulse sensors to detect window position.
3.
SYSTEM FUNCTION
The power window control system has the following
functions.
Function
Outline
Manual UP / DOWN function
Driver side power window: Function that causes window to rise while
power window switch is pulled halfway up, and lower while pushed
halfway down. Window stops as soon as switch is released.
Other power windows: Function that causes window to rise while
power window switch is pulled up and to lower while pushed down.
Window stops as soon as switch is released.
AUTO UP / DOWN function
Function that enables window of driver side door to be fully opened or
fully closed by one full push downward or one full pull upward on
power window switch, respectively. AUTO UP / DOWN function is only
available on driver side power window.
Jam protection function
Function that automatically stops driver side power window and
moves it downward if object is jammed in driver side power window
during AUTO UP operation. During key-off operation function, jam
protection function works for manual UP and AUTO UP operation.
Jam protection function is only available on driver side power window.
Remote UP / DOWN function
Function that allows power window master switch to control manual
UP / DOWN operations of passenger side power window and rear
power windows.
Key-off operation function
Function where power window operation can be performed
approximately 43 seconds even if power switch is turned OFF (either
front door must not be opened).
Window lock function
Function where passenger side power window and rear power
windows' operations are disabled when window lock switch of the
master switch is pressed. Passenger side power window and rear
power windows can be operated when window lock switch is pressed
again.
WS
WS–8
WS
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
Function
Outline
Diagnosis
Function where power window switch can detect malfunctions in
power window system and make diagnoses. Power window switch
light (AUTO light) illuminates or starts blinking to inform driver.
Fail-safe
Function that disables driver side power window AUTO UP / DOWN
function if pulse sensor (Hall IC) in power window regulator motor has
malfunction. Manual operation is possible through power window
switches.
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
WS–9
INITIALIZATION
1.
RESET (INITIALIZE) POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
MOTOR (for Driver Side)
NOTICE:
Resetting the power window regulator motor
(initializing the pulse sensor) is necessary if: 1) the
battery terminal cable is disconnected; 2) the power
window regulator master switch assembly, wire
harness, power window regulator switch, power
window regulator assembly and power window
regulator motor are replaced or removed / installed;
or 3) the PWR H-fuse, FR DOOR fuse, GAUGE fuse
and ECU-IG fuse are replaced. If resetting is not
performed, the master switch assembly will not be
able to operate the AUTO operation function, jam
protection function and remote UP / DOWN function.
(a) *1: Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) *2: Open the power window halfway by pressing the
power window switch.
(c) *3: Fully pull up on the switch until the power
window is fully closed and continue to hold the
switch for at least 1 second.
(d) *4: Check that the AUTO UP / DOWN function
operates normally.
If the AUTO UP / DOWN function operates normally,
reset operations are complete. If abnormal, follow
steps below.
(e) Disconnect the negative (-) battery terminal cable
for 10 seconds.
(f) Connect the battery terminal cable.
(g) Perform steps *1 to *4 again.
WS
WS–10
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
Use the table below to help determine the cause of the
problem symptom. The potential causes of the symptoms are
listed in order of probability in the "Suspected area" column of
the table. Check each symptom by checking the suspected
areas in the order they are listed. Replace parts as
necessary.
Power window control system
Symptom
Suspected area
1. Power window regulator motor front LH
AUTO UP / DOWN function does not operate
See page
WS-20
2. Wire harness
3. Power window regulator master switch
Remote UP / DOWN function does not operate
1. Power window regulator master switch
2. Wire harness
1. FR DOOR fuse
Manual UP / DOWN function does not operate on
driver side
WS-23
WS-47
2. Power window regulator master switch
3. Power window regulator motor front LH
4. Wire harness
1. Power window regulator switch front RH
Manual UP / DOWN function does not operate on
passenger side only
WS-25
2. Power window regulator motor front RH
3. Wire harness
1. Power window regulator switch rear LH
Manual UP / DOWN function does not operate on rear
LH side only
WS-29
2. Power window regulator motor rear LH
3. Wire harness
1. Power window regulator switch rear RH
Manual UP / DOWN function does not operate on rear
RH side only
WS-33
2. Power window regulator motor rear RH
3. Wire harness
Jam protection function does not operate
WS
1. Power window regulator master switch
WS-46
1. AM2 fuse
WS-37
2. GAUGE fuse
3. PWR H-fuse
4. ECU-IG fuse
Power windows do not operate at all
5. FR DOOR fuse
6. PWR relay
7. IG1 relay
8. Power window regulator master switch
9. Wire harness
10. Driver side junction block (Body ECU)
1. Power window regulator master switch
Power window can be operated after power switch is
turned OFF even if operative conditions are not met
WS-41
2. Front door courtesy light switch
3. Wire harness
4. Driver side junction block (Body ECU)
1. Front door window regulator
AUTO UP operate does not fully close power window
(jam protection function is activated)
2. Power window regulator motor front LH
3. Power window regulator master switch
WS-44
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
WS–11
TERMINALS OF ECU
1.
CHECK POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MASTER
SWITCH
P17
9 8 7 6 5 4 3 2 1
18 17 16 15 14 13 12 11 10
E124642E01
(a) Disconnect the P17 switch connector.
(b) Measure the voltage and resistance of the wire
harness side connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
E (P17-1) - Body ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
BW (P17-7) - E (P17-1)
W - W-B
Regulator motor power
supply
Always
10 to 14 V
B (P17-6) - E (P17-1)
L - W-B
Master switch power
supply
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
BDR (P17-11) - E (P17-1)
V - W-B
Master switch power
supply
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
(c) Reconnect the P17 switch connector.
(d) Reset the power window motor (see page WS-7).
(e) Measure the voltage of the connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
DU (P17-4) - E (P17-1)
Y - W-B
Power window motor UP
output
Power switch ON (IG),
driver side power window
switch OFF
Below 1 V
DU (P17-4) - E (P17-1)
Y - W-B
Power window motor UP
output
Power switch ON (IG),
driver side power window
switch UP (manual
operation)
10 to 14 V
DU (P17-4) - E (P17-1)
Y - W-B
Power window motor UP
output
Power switch ON (IG),
driver side power window
fully open
Below 1 V
DU (P17-4) - E (P17-1)
Y - W-B
Power window motor UP
output
Power switch ON (IG),
driver side power window
switch UP (AUTO
operation)
10 to 14 V
DU (P17-4) - E (P17-1)
Y - W-B
Power window motor UP
output
Power switch ON (IG),
driver side power window
fully closed
Below 1 V
DD (P17-9) - E (P17-1)
G - W-B
Power window motor
DOWN output
Power switch ON (IG),
driver side power window
switch OFF
Below 1 V
DD (P17-9) - E (P17-1)
G - W-B
Power window motor
DOWN output
Power switch ON (IG),
driver side power window
switch DOWN (manual
operation)
10 to 14 V
WS
WS–12
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
DD (P17-9) - E (P17-1)
G - W-B
Power window motor
DOWN output
Power switch ON (IG),
driver side power window
fully closed
Below 1 V
DD (P17-9) - E (P17-1)
G - W-B
Power window motor
DOWN output
Power switch ON (IG),
driver side power window
switch DOWN (AUTO
operation)
10 to 14 V
DD (P17-9) - E (P17-1)
G - W-B
Power window motor
DOWN output
Power switch ON (IG),
driver side power window
fully open
Below 1 V
VCC (P17-3) - GND (P172)
G-O
•
Always
10 to 14 V
•
Power window motor
power source
Power window motor
sensor ground
(f)
WS
If the result is not as specified, the master switch
may have a malfunction.
Check the AUTO light illumination.
(1) When turning the power switch ON (IG), check
that the AUTO light illuminates (green).
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
2.
1D
WS–13
CHECK DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK (MAIN
BODY ECU)
1A
1E
1B
1D
1E
1A
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
16
17
18
19
20
21
22
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
19
20
21
22
23
24
25
26
8
9
10
11
23
24
25
26
9
10
11
12
27
28
29
30
12
13
14
15
27
28
29
30
13
14
15
16
17
18
31
32
33
34
35
36
1B
1
1
2
3
4
5
6
7
8
17
18
19
20
21
22
23
24
9
10
11
12
25
26
27
28
13
14
15
16
29
30
31
32
WS
E124647E01
(a) Disconnect the 1A, 1D, 1E and 1B junction block
connectors.
(b) Measure the voltage and resistance of the wire
harness side connectors.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
ECUB (1A-30) - Body
ground
R - Body ground
+B (ECUB) power supply
Always
10 to 14 V
WS–14
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
ALTB (1B-1) - Body
ground
W - Body ground
+B (power system,
generator system) power
supply
Always
10 to 14 V
KSW (1E-26) - Body
ground
Y - Body ground
Halfway switch input
No key in key slot
10 kΩ or higher
KSW (1E-26) - Body
ground
Y - Body ground
Halfway switch input
Key inserted
Below 1 Ω
DCTY (1D-21) - Body
ground
V - Body ground
Driver side courtesy
switch input
Driver side door closed
10 kΩ or higher
DCTY (1D-21) - Body
ground
V - Body ground
Driver side courtesy
switch input
Driver side door open
Below 1 Ω
PCTY (1D-24) - Body
ground P
BR - Body ground
Passenger side courtesy
switch input
Passenger side door
closed
10 kΩ or higher
PCTY (1D-24) - Body
ground
BR - Body ground
Passenger side courtesy
switch input
Passenger side door open
Below 1 Ω
GND (1E-17) - Body
ground
W-B - Body ground
Ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, there may be a
malfunction on the wire harness side.
(c) Reconnect the 1A, 1D, 1E and 1B junction block
connectors.
(d) Measure the voltage of the connector.
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Wiring Color
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
KSW (1E-26) - Body
ground
Y - Body ground
Halfway switch input
No key in key slot
10 to 14 V
KSW (1E-26) - Body
ground
Y - Body ground
Halfway switch input
Key inserted
Below 1 V
If the result is not as specified, the junction block
(main body ECU) may have a malfunction.
DIAGNOSIS SYSTEM
1.
CG SG CANH SIL
WS
CANL
CHECK DLC3
HINT:
The vehicle uses the ISO 15765-4 communication
protocol. The terminal arrangement of the DLC3
complies with SAE J1962 and matches the ISO 15765-4
format.
BAT
H100769E16
Symbols (Terminal No.)
Terminal Description
Condition
Specified Condition
SIL (7) - SG (5)
Bus '+' line
During transmission
Pulse generation
CG (4) - Body ground
Chassis ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
SG (5) - Body ground
Signal ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
BAT (16) - Body ground
Battery positive
Always
10 to 14 V
CANH (6) - CANL (14)
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Power switch OFF*
54 to 69 Ω
CANH (6) - CG (4)
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Power switch OFF*
1 kΩ or more
CANL (14) - CG(4)
HIGH-level CAN bus line
Power switch OFF*
1 kΩ or more
CANH (6) - BAT (16)
LOW-level CAN bus line
Power switch OFF*
1 kΩ or more
CANL (14) - BAT (16)
LOW-level CAN bus line
Power switch OFF*
1 kΩ or more
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
Intelligent Tester
CAN VIM
DLC3
A082795E01
2.
WS–15
NOTICE:
*: Before measuring the resistance, leave the vehicle
as is for at least 1 minute and do not operate the
power switch, any other switches or the doors.
If the result is not as specified, the DLC3 may have a
malfunction. Repair or replace the harness and
connector.
HINT:
Connect the cable of the intelligent tester (with CAN
VIM) to the DLC3, turn the power switch ON (IG) and
attempt to use the intelligent tester. If the display informs
that a communication error has occurred, there is a
problem either with the vehicle or with the tester.
• If communication is normal when the tester is
connected to another vehicle, inspect the DLC3 of the
original vehicle.
• If communication is still impossible when the tester is
connected to another vehicle, the problem is probably
in the tester itself. Consult the Service Department
listed in the tester's instruction manual.
INSPECT BATTERY VOLTAGE
Standard:
11 to 14 V
If the voltage is below 11 V, replace the battery before
proceeding.
WS
WS–16
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
DATA LIST / ACTIVE TEST
1.
READ DATA LIST
HINT:
Using the intelligent tester's DATA LIST allows switch,
sensor, actuator and other item values to be read without
removing any parts. Reading the DATA LIST early in
troubleshooting is one way to save time.
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(c) Read the DATA LIST according to the display on the
tester.
Body ECU
Item
Measurement Item / Display
(Range)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
D DOR CTY SW
Driver side door courtesy switch
signal / ON or OFF
ON: Driver side door is open
OFF: Driver side door is closed
-
P DOR CTY SW
Passenger side door courtesy
switch signal / ON or OFF
ON: Passenger side door is open
OFF: Passenger side door is
closed
-
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
CHECK WINDOW LOCK SWITCH
(a) Check that the passenger side power window and
rear power window operation are disabled when the
window lock switch of the power window regulator
master switch is pressed.
(b) Check that the passenger side power window and
rear power windows can be operated when the
window lock switch is pressed again.
2.
CHECK MANUAL UP / DOWN FUNCTION
(a) Check that the driver side power window operates
as follows:
B066761
WS
OK
Condition
Master Switch
Switch Operation
Power Window
Power switch ON (IG)
Driver side
Pulled halfway up
UP (closed)
Power switch ON (IG)
Driver side
Pushed halfway down
DOWN (open)
(b) Check that the passenger side power window
operates as follows:
OK
Condition
Regulator Switch
Switch Operation
Power Window
•
•
Power switch ON (IG)
Window lock switch OFF
Passenger side
Pulled up
UP (closed)
•
•
Power switch ON (IG)
Window lock switch OFF
Passenger side
Pushed down
DOWN (open)
(c) Check that the rear LH power window operates as
follows:
OK
Condition
Regulator Switch
Switch Operation
Power Window
•
•
Power switch ON (IG)
Window lock switch OFF
Rear LH
Pulled up
UP (closed)
•
•
Power switch ON (IG)
Window lock switch OFF
Rear LH
Pushed down
DOWN (open)
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
WS–17
(d) Check that the rear RH power window operates as
follows:
OK
Condition
Regulator Switch
Switch Operation
Power Window
•
•
Power switch ON (IG)
Window lock switch OFF
Rear RH
Pulled up
UP (closed)
•
•
Power switch ON (IG)
Window lock switch OFF
Rear RH
Pushed down
DOWN (open)
3.
CHECK AUTO UP / DOWN FUNCTION
(a) Check that the driver side power window operates
as follows:
OK
Condition
Master Switch
Switch Operation
Power Window
Power switch ON (IG)
Driver side
Pulled fully up
AUTO UP (fully closed)
Power switch ON (IG)
Driver side
Pushed fully down
AUTO DOWN (fully open)
4.
CHECK REMOTE UP / DOWN FUNCTION
(a) Check that the passenger side power window
operates as follows:
OK
Condition
Regulator Switch
Switch Operation
Power Window
•
•
Power switch ON (IG)
Window lock switch OFF
Passenger side
Pulled up
UP (closed)
•
•
Power switch ON (IG)
Window lock switch OFF
Passenger side
Pushed down
DOWN (open)
(b) Check that the rear LH power window operates as
follows:
OK
Condition
Regulator Switch
Switch Operation
Power Window
•
•
Power switch ON (IG)
Window lock switch OFF
Rear LH
Pulled up
UP (closed)
•
•
Power switch ON (IG)
Window lock switch OFF
Rear LH
Pushed down
DOWN (open)
WS
(c) Check that the rear RH power window operates as
follows:
OK
Condition
Regulator Switch
Switch Operation
Power Window
•
•
Power switch ON (IG)
Window lock switch OFF
Rear RH
Pulled up
UP (closed)
•
•
Power switch ON (IG)
Window lock switch OFF
Rear RH
Pushed down
DOWN (open)
WS–18
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
5.
CHECK JAM PROTECTION FUNCTION
HINT:
• The jam protection function helps prevent any part of
your body from getting caught by accident between
the door frame and the door glass during power
window operation.
• The jam protection function is only available on the
driver side power window.
NOTICE:
If the power window motor has just been reset, raise
and lower the door glass several times manually
before performing the check.
(a) Check that the door glass lowers by approximately
50 mm (1.97 in.) when something is caught between
the door frame and door glass during power window
operation. However, when the opening between the
door frame and the door glass is less than 200 mm
(7.87 in.), the door glass continues to lower and
does not stop until an opening of 200 mm (7.87 in.)
is achieved. Operative conditions:
• AUTO UP
• AUTO UP function after turning power switch
OFF
• MANUAL UP function after turning power switch
OFF
6.
CHECK POWER WINDOW FAIL-SAFE FUNCTION
(a) The power window regulator motor's pulse sensors
detect when an object has been jammed in the
window. If a pulse sensor has a malfunction, the failsafe function starts operating and the AUTO UP /
DOWN function will be disabled.
7.
CHECK PTC OPERATION
HINT:
PTC operation is a function that prevents overloading of
the power window regulator by stopping the motor. PTC
operation activates when the power window regulator
switch is operated for a predetermined amount of time.
(a) Pull up and hold the power window regulator switch
for more than 90 seconds. Then release the switch.
(b) Check that pressing the switch does not move the
window.
(c) Wait until 60 seconds have passed since the switch
was released in the first step. Check that pressing
the switch results in normal window movement.
Thick Book
E124619E01
WS
WS–19
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MASTER
SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Measure the resistance of the switch when the
switch is operated.
Window Lock Switch
Front Passenger Switch
PD
PU
Rear RH Switch
RRD
RLU
RRU
RLD
Driver Switch
DD
Rear LH Switch
E
DU
B
BW
E124624E01
Standard resistance:
Driver switch
Tester Connection
Window Lock Switch Condition
Power Window Switch
Condition
Specified Condition
1 (E) - 9 (DD)
Always
(ON / OFF)
UP
Below 1 Ω
Always
(ON / OFF)
AUTO UP
Below 1 Ω
Always
(ON / OFF)
OFF
Below 1 Ω
Always
(ON / OFF)
DOWN
Below 1 Ω
Always
(ON / OFF)
AUTO DOWN
Below 1 Ω
4 (DU) - 7 (BW)
1 (E) - 9 (DD)
4 (DU) - 7 (BW)
1 (E) - 4 (DU)
1 (E) - 9 (DD)
1 (E) - 4 (DU)
7 (BW) - 9 (DD)
1 (E) - 4 (DU)
7 (BW) - 9 (DD)
Passenger switch
Tester Connection
Window Lock Switch Condition
Power Window Switch
Condition
Specified Condition
1 (E) - 15 (PD)
OFF
UP
Below 1 Ω
OFF
OFF
Below 1 Ω
OFF
DOWN
Below 1 Ω
ON
UP
6 (B) - 13 (PU)
1 (E) - 13 (PU)
1 (E) - 15 (PD)
1 (E) - 13 (PU)
6 (B) - 15 (PD)
1 (E) - 15 (PD)
10 kΩ or higher
Below 1 Ω
6 (B) - 13 (PU)
13 (PU) - 15 (PD)
ON
OFF
Below 1 Ω
1 (E) - 13 (PU)
ON
DOWN
10 kΩ or higher
Below 1 Ω
6 (B) - 15 (PD)
Rear LH switch
WS
WS–20
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
Tester Connection
Window Lock Switch Condition
Power Window Switch
Condition
Specified Condition
1 (E) - 10 (RLD)
OFF
UP
Below 1 Ω
OFF
OFF
Below 1 Ω
OFF
DOWN
Below 1 Ω
ON
UP
10 kΩ or higher
12 (RLU) - 10 (RLD)
ON
OFF
1 (E) - 12 (RLU)
ON
DOWN
6 (B) - 12 (RLU)
1 (E) - 12 (RLU)
1 (E) - 10 (RLD)
1 (E) - 12 (RLU)
6 (B) - 10 (RLD)
1 (E) - 10 (RLD)
Below 1 Ω
6 (B) - 12 (RLU)
Below 1 Ω
10 kΩ or higher
Below 1 Ω
6 (B) - 10 (RLD)
Rear RH switch
Tester Connection
Window Lock Switch Condition
Power Window Switch
Condition
Specified Condition
1 (E) - 16 (RRD)
OFF
UP
Below 1 Ω
OFF
OFF
Below 1 Ω
OFF
DOWN
Below 1 Ω
ON
UP
10 kΩ or higher
18 (RRU) - 16 (RRD)
ON
OFF
1 (E) - 18 (RRU)
ON
DOWN
6 (B) - 18 (RRU)
1 (E) - 18 (RRU)
1 (E) - 16 (RRD)
1 (E) - 18 (RRU)
6 (B) - 16 (RRD)
1 (E) - 16 (RRD)
Below 1 Ω
6 (B) - 18 (RRU)
Below 1 Ω
10 kΩ or higher
Below 1 Ω
6 (B) - 16 (RRD)
If the result is not as specified, replace the master
switch assembly.
(b) Apply battery voltage to the master switch and
check that the AUTO light illuminates.
WS
Master Switch
AUTO Light
BDR
E
E124625E01
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
WS–21
OK
Measurement Condition
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 11
(BDR)
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 1 (E)
AUTO light illuminates
If the result is not as specified, replace the master
switch assembly.
2.
B063163
INSPECT POWER WINDOW REGULATOR SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
(a) Measure the resistance of the switch when the
switch is operated.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
3-4
UP
Below 1 Ω
1-2
3-5
OFF
Below 1 Ω
1-4
3-5
DOWN
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the regulator
switch assembly.
3.
Front LH and Rear LH
Counterclockwise
Clockwise
Motor Gear
B086401E06
INSPECT POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR
ASSEMBLY (for Front LH and Rear LH)
(a) Apply battery voltage to connector terminals 1 and
2.
NOTICE:
Do not apply battery voltage to any terminals
except terminals 1 and 2.
(b) Check that the motor gear rotates smoothly as
follows.
OK
Measurement Condition
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 2
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 1
Motor gear rotates clockwise
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 1
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 2
Motor gear rotates counterclockwise
If the result is not as specified, replace the regulator
motor assembly.
4.
Front RH and Rear RH
Clockwise
Motor Gear
Counterclockwise
B086400E05
INSPECT POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR
ASSEMBLY (for Front RH and Rear RH)
(a) Apply battery voltage to connector terminals 1 and
2.
NOTICE:
Do not apply battery voltage to any terminals
except terminals 1 and 2.
(b) Check that the motor gear rotates smoothly as
follows.
OK
Measurement Condition
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 1
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 2
Motor gear rotates clockwise
WS
WS–22
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
Measurement Condition
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 2
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 1
Motor gear rotates counterclockwise
If the result is not as specified, replace the regulator
motor assembly.
WS
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
WS–23
Auto Up / Down Function does not Operate
DESCRIPTION
If the AUTO UP / DOWN function does not operate, the cause may be one or more of the following:
• The recorded power window fully closed position, which is stored in the power window regulator
master switch, was erased as a result of: 1) the PWR H-fuse or the power window relay (PWR) being
replaced; or 2) the battery cable and the master switch's connector being disconnected.
• The master switch has a malfunction.
• The pulse sensors in the driver side power window regulator motor have a malfunction.
• The wiring between the master switch and the driver side power window regulator motor is open or
short circuited.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Power Window Regulator
Motor Front LH
Power Window Regulator
Master Switch
SSRB
PLS
PLS2
VCC
PLS
PLS
PLS2
PLS2
E
GND
WS
E124627E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK MANUAL UP / DOWN FUNCTION (for Driver Side)
(a) Check if the manual UP / DOWN function operates
normally.
OK :
Manual UP / DOWN function operates normally.
NG
OK
OTHER PROBLEM
WS–24
2
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MASTER SWITCH ASSEMBLY (for AUTO Light)
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Operate the master switch assembly's driver side switch
for 2 seconds or more.
(c) Check the blinking pattern of the AUTO light. Compare
the blinking pattern with the illustration below.
AUTO Light
E124628E01
Blinking Pattern of AUTO Light
1: Fully closed
position is
misaligned
2: Pulse sensor
circuit malfunction
3: Both 1 and 2
4: Normal
ON
OFF
(Light)
1.5
2.0 (sec.)
1.5
0.5
(sec.)
1.0
1.0
2.0
(sec.)
0.5
E124629E01
Result
WS
Blinking Pattern
Proceed to
1 or 3
A
2
B
4
C
B
C
Go to step 4
REPLACE POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
MASTER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
A
3
RESET POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR ASSEMBLY FRONT LH
(a) Check if the power window operates normally after the
reset.
OK:
Power window operates normally.
OK
END
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
WS–25
NG
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (MASTER SWITCH - REGULATOR MOTOR)
(a) Disconnect the P17 switch connector.
(b) Disconnect the P18 motor connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Power Window Regulator
Master Switch
GND
VCC
P17
PLS
PLS2
Power Window Regulator
Motor Front LH
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
P17-3 (VCC) - P18-4 (SSRB)
Below 1 Ω
P17-14 (PLS) - P18-5 (PLS)
Below 1 Ω
P17-17 (PLS2) - P18-3 (PLS2)
Below 1 Ω
P17-2 (GND) - P18-6 (E)
Below 1 Ω
P17-3 (VCC) or P18-4 (SSRB) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
P17-14 (PLS) or P18-5 (PLS) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
P17-17 (PLS2) or P18-3 (PLS2) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
P18
1
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
2
3 4 5 6
PLS2
E
SSRB
PLS
E124630E01
OK
REPLACE POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR ASSEMBLY FRONT LH
WS
WS–26
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
Remote Up / Down Function does not Operate
DESCRIPTION
With the power switch ON (IG), the power window regulator master switch transmits remote switch signals
to the regulator switches of the passenger door power window and rear door power windows. Then, the
regulator switches drive the power window regulator motors.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Power Window Regulator
Master Switch
Power Window Regulator Switch
Front RH
PU
PD
Power Window Regulator Switch
Rear LH
RLU
RLD
WS
Power Window Regulator Switch
Rear RH
RRU
RRD
from Battery
to Body Ground
B
E
E124631E01
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
WS–27
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MASTER SWITCH ASSEMBLY (for Window Lock
Switch)
(a) Turn the window lock switch OFF and operate the
switches on the master switch. Check that the remote
UP / DOWN function operates normally.
OK:
Remote UP / DOWN function operates normally.
OK
END
B066761
NG
2
CHECK MANUAL UP / DOWN FUNCTION
(a) Check that the passenger door power window and rear
door power windows' manual UP / DOWN functions
operate normally.
OK:
Manual UP / DOWN functions operate normally.
NG
OTHER PROBLEM
OK
REPLACE POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MASTER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
WS
WS–28
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
Manual Up / Down Function does not Operate on Passenger Side Only
DESCRIPTION
If the passenger side manual UP / DOWN function does not operate, a malfunction may be present in the
power window regulator motor, the power window regulator switch, power window regulator master switch
or the wire harness.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Power Window Regulator
Motor Front RH
Power Window Regulator
Switch Front RH
M
from
PWR Relay
Power Window Regulator
Master Switch
WS
PU
PD
E124632E01
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
WS–29
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK POWER WINDOW REGULATOR SWITCH ASSEMBLY FRONT RH (POWER
SOURCE VOLTAGE)
(a) Disconnect the P14 switch connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
P14
1 2 3 4 5
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
P14-4 - Body ground
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
NG
B106251E01
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR (DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION
BLOCK - REGULATOR SWITCH)
OK
2
INSPECT POWER WINDOW REGULATOR SWITCH ASSEMBLY FRONT RH
(a) Check the regulator switch (see page WS-52).
NG
REPLACE POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
SWITCH ASSEMBLY FRONT RH
OK
WS
WS–30
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (REGULATOR SWITCH - REGULATOR MOTOR)
(a) Disconnect the P14 switch connector.
(b) Disconnect the P19 motor connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Power Window Regulator
Switch Front RH
P14
1 2 3 4 5
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
P14-1 - P19-1
Below 1 Ω
P14-3 - P19-2
Below 1 Ω
P14-1 or P19-1 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
P14-3 or P19-2 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
Power Window Regulator
Motor Front RH
P19
1
2
3 4 5 6
E124637E01
WS
OK
4
INSPECT POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR ASSEMBLY FRONT RH
(a) Check the regulator motor (see page WS-54).
NG
OK
REPLACE POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
MOTOR
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
5
WS–31
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (MASTER SWITCH - REGULATOR SWITCH)
(a) Disconnect the P17 switch connector.
(b) Disconnect the P14 switch connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Power Window Regulator
Master Switch
P17
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
P17-13 (PU) - P14-5
Below 1 Ω
P17-15 (PD) - P14-2
Below 1 Ω
P17-13 (PU) or P14-5 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
P17-15 (PD) or P14-2 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
PU
PD
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
Power Window Regulator
Switch Front RH
P14
1 2 3 4 5
E124638E01
OK
REPLACE POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MASTER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
WS
WS–32
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
Manual Up / Down Function does not Operate on Rear LH Only
DESCRIPTION
If the rear LH side manual UP / DOWN function does not operate, a malfunction may be present in the
power window regulator motor, power window regulator switch, power window regulator master switch or
wire harness.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Power Window Regulator
Motor Rear LH
Power Window Regulator
Switch Rear LH
M
from
PWR Relay
Power Window Regulator
Master Switch
WS
RLU
RLD
E124632E03
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
WS–33
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK POWER WINDOW REGULATOR SWITCH ASSEMBLY REAR LH (POWER
SOURCE VOLTAGE)
(a) Disconnect the P15 switch connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
P15
1 2 3 4 5
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
P15-4 - Body ground
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
NG
B106251E04
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR (DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION
BLOCK - REGULATOR SWITCH)
OK
2
INSPECT POWER WINDOW REGULATOR SWITCH ASSEMBLY REAR LH
(a) Check the regulator switch (see page WS-53).
NG
REPLACE POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
SWITCH ASSEMBLY REAR LH
OK
WS
WS–34
3
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (REGULATOR SWITCH - REGULATOR MOTOR)
(a) Disconnect the P15 switch connector.
(b) Disconnect the P20 motor connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Power Window Regulator
Switch Rear LH
P15
1 2 3 4 5
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
P15-1 - P20-1
Below 1 Ω
P15-3 - P20-2
Below 1 Ω
P15-1 or P20-1 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
P15-3 or P20-2 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
Power Window Regulator
Motor Rear LH
P20
1
2
3 4 5 6
E124637E02
WS
OK
4
INSPECT POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR ASSEMBLY REAR LH
(a) Check the regulator motor (see page WS-54).
NG
OK
REPLACE POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
MOTOR
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
5
WS–35
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (MASTER SWITCH - REGULATOR SWITCH)
(a) Disconnect the P17 switch connector.
(b) Disconnect the P15 switch connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Power Window Regulator
Master Switch
P17
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
P17-12 (RLU) - P15-5
Below 1 Ω
P17-10 (RLD) - P15-2
Below 1 Ω
P17-12 (RLU) or P15-5 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
P17-10 (RLD) or P15-2 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
RLD
RLU
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
Power Window Regulator
Switch Front LH
P15
1 2 3 4 5
E124638E02
OK
REPLACE POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MASTER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
WS
WS–36
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
Manual Up / Down Function does not Operate on Rear RH Only
DESCRIPTION
If the rear RH side manual UP / DOWN function does not operate, a malfunction may be present in the
power window regulator motor, power window regulator switch, power window regulator master switch or
wire harness.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Power Window Regulator
Motor Rear RH
Power Window Regulator
Switch Rear RH
M
from
PWR Relay
Power Window Regulator
Master Switch
WS
RRU
RRD
E124632E04
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
WS–37
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK POWER WINDOW REGULATOR SWITCH ASSEMBLY REAR RH (POWER
SOURCE VOLTAGE)
(a) Disconnect the P16 switch connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
P16
1 2 3 4 5
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
P16-4 - Body ground
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
NG
B106251E07
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR (DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION
BLOCK - REGULATOR SWITCH)
OK
2
INSPECT POWER WINDOW REGULATOR SWITCH ASSEMBLY REAR RH
(a) Check the regulator switch (see page WS-53).
NG
REPLACE POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
SWITCH ASSEMBLY REAR RH
OK
WS
WS–38
3
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (REGULATOR SWITCH - REGULATOR MOTOR)
(a) Disconnect the P16 switch connector.
(b) Disconnect the P21 motor connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Power Window Regulator
Switch Rear RH
P16
1 2 3 4 5
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
P16-1 - P21-1
Below 1 Ω
P16-3 - P21-2
Below 1 Ω
P16-1 or P21-1 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
P16-3 or P21-2 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
Power Window Regulator
Motor Rear RH
P21
1
2
3 4 5 6
E124637E04
WS
OK
4
INSPECT POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR ASSEMBLY REAR RH
(a) Check the regulator motor (see page WS-54).
NG
OK
REPLACE POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
MOTOR
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
5
WS–39
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (REGULATOR MASTER SWITCH - REGULATOR SWITCH)
(a) Disconnect the P17 switch connector.
(b) Disconnect the P16 switch connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Power Window Regulator
Master Switch
P17
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
P17-18 (RRU) - P16-5
Below 1 Ω
P17-16 (RRD) - P16-2
Below 1 Ω
P17-18 (RRU) or P16-5 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
P17-16 (RRD) or P16-2 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
RRD
RRU
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
Power Window Regulator
Switch Rear RH
P16
1 2 3 4 5
E124638E03
OK
REPLACE POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MASTER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
WS
WS–40
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
Power Windows do not Operate at All
DESCRIPTION
If all of the power windows do not operate, the power window regulator master switch may have no power
or may be malfunctioning.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Power Source
Control ECU
Driver Side Junction Block
AM2
from Battery
AM1
IG1
IG1D
from Battery
Power Window Regulator
Master Switch
GAUGE
BDR
WS
ECU-IG
FR DOOR
BW
PWR
POWER
B
E
GND
KOF
SIG
Body ECU
E124634E01
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
WS–41
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
INSPECT FUSE (AM2, GAUGE, FR DOOR, ECU-IG)
(a) Remove the AM2 fuse from the engine room junction
block.
(b) Remove the GAUGE, FR DOOR and ECU-IG fuses from
the driver side junction block.
(c) Measure the resistance of the fuses.
Standard resistance:
Below 1 Ω
NG
REPLACE FUSE
OK
2
INSPECT IG1 RELAY
(a) Remove the IG1 relay from the driver side junction block.
(b) Measure the resistance of the relay.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
3-5
10 kΩ or higher
3-5
Below 1 Ω (when battery voltage is
applied to terminals 1 and 2)
NG
A092673E28
REPLACE IG1 RELAY
OK
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (MASTER SWITCH - BATTERY AND BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the P17 switch connector.
(b) Measure the voltage or resistance of the wire harness
side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
E
B
BW
P17
BDR
E124648E01
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
P17-6 (B) - Body ground
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
P17-7 (BW) - Body
ground
Always
10 to 14 V
P17-11 (BDR) - Body
ground
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
P17-1 (E) - Body ground
Always
Below 1 Ω
OK
REPLACE POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
MASTER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
WS
WS–42
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
NG
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (MASTER SWITCH - JUNCTION BLOCK)
(a) Disconnect the P17 switch connector.
(b) Disconnect the 1G and 1H junction block connectors.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Wire Harness Side
Power Window Regulator
Master Switch
B
BW
P17
BDR
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
P17-11 (BDR) - 1G-6
Below 1 Ω
P17-7 (BW) - 1H-10
Below 1 Ω
P17-6 (B) - 1H-11
Below 1 Ω
P17-11 (BDR) or 1G-6 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
P17-7 (BW) or 1H-10 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
P17-6 (B) or 1H-11 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
Driver Side Junction Block
1G
WS
Driver Side Junction Block
1H
E124639E01
OK
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
5
WS–43
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (JUNCTION BLOCK - BODY GROUND)
(a) Disconnect the 1B and 1E junction block connectors.
(b) Measure the voltage and resistance of the wire harness
side connectors.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
Driver Side Junction Block
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1B-1 - Body ground
10 to 14 V
Standard resistance
1B
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
1E-17 - Body ground
Below 1 Ω
NG
Driver Side Junction Block
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
1E
E124643E01
OK
6
CHECK BASIC FUNCTION OF PUSH BUTTON START SYSTEM
(a) Check that the push button start system operates
normally.
OK:
Push button start system operates normally.
NG
GO TO PUSH BUTTON START SYSTEM
OK
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK ASSEMBLY
WS
WS–44
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
Power Window can be Operated After Power Switch is Turned OFF
Even if Operative Conditions are not Met
DESCRIPTION
The body ECU keeps power supplied to the power window regulator master switch and the regulator
switch for 43 seconds after the power switch is turned OFF. However, the body ECU will cut power to the
master switch if: 1) either front door is opened, 2) a signal from either of the front door courtesy light
switches is input to the ECU within the 43 seconds, or 3) 43 seconds have passed.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Driver Side Junction Block
Power Window Regulator Master Switch
and Power Window Regulator Switches
(Front RH, Rear LH and Rear RH)
Body ECU
PWR
PWR
from Battery
KOF
E
WS
PCTY
DCTY
Front Door Courtesy
Light Switch RH
Front Door Courtesy
Light Switch LH
E124635E01
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
WS–45
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK OPERATION FUNCTION AFTER POWER SWITCH IS TURNED OFF
(a) After turning the power switch OFF:
(1) If either front door is opened within 43 seconds but
the power window can still operate, proceed to A.
(2) If 43 seconds pass but the power window can still
operate, proceed to B.
B
REPLACE POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
MASTER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
A
2
READ DATA LIST OF INTELLIGENT TESTER (COURTESY LIGHT SWITCH)
(a) Connect the intelligent tester (with CAN VIM) to the
DLC3.
(b) Turn the power switch ON (IG) and press the intelligent
tester main switch ON.
(c) Read the DATA LIST according to the displays on the
tester.
Multiplex network body ECU
Item
Measurement Item/Range
(Display)
Normal Condition
Diagnostic Note
D DOR CTY SW
Driver side door courtesy light
switch signal / ON or OFF
ON: Driver side door is open
OFF: Driver side door is closed
-
P DOR CTY SW
Passenger side door courtesy
light switch signal / ON or OFF
ON: Passenger side door is open
OFF: Passenger side door is
closed
-
OK:
ON (door is open) appears on the screen.
OK
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK
ASSEMBLY
NG
3
INSPECT FRONT DOOR COURTESY LIGHT SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Measure the resistance.
Standard voltage
Not Pushed
Pushed
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
1 - Switch body
Pushed
10 kΩ or higher
1 - Switch body
Not pushed
Below 1 Ω
NG
Switch Body
B058556E13
REPLACE FRONT DOOR COURTESY LIGHT
SWITCH ASSEMBLY
WS
WS–46
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
OK
4
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (COURTESY LIGHT SWITCH - JUNCTION BLOCK)
Wire Harness Side
Front Door Courtesy Light Switch
D7
D8
*1
*2
1
*1: for LH Side
*2: for RH Side
(a) Disconnect the D7*1 or D8*2 switch connector.
(b) Disconnect the 1D junction block connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
D7-1 - 1D-21 (DCTY)
Below 1 Ω
D8-1 - 1D-24 (PCTY)
Below 1 Ω
D7-1 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
D8-1 - Body ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
Driver Side Junction Block
1D
DCTY
PCTY
E124641E01
WS
OK
REPLACE DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION BLOCK (BODY ECU)
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
WS–47
Auto Up Operation does not Fully Close Power Window (Jam
Protection Function is Activated)
DESCRIPTION
If the door glass or the power window regulator motor does not operate smoothly, the jam protection
function may trigger automatically, resulting in the AUTO UP function being unable to fully close the
window.
HINT:
The jam protection function is only available on the driver side power window.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Power Window Regulator
Motor Front LH
Power Window Regulator
Master Switch
SSRB
PLS
PLS2
VCC
PLS
PLS
PLS2
PLS2
E
GND
E124627E01
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
RESET POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR FRONT LH
(a) Reset the power window regulator motor (see page WS7).
(b) Check that the power window AUTO UP / DOWN
function operates normally.
OK:
AUTO UP / DOWN function operates normally.
OK
END
NG
2
CHECK POWER WINDOW REGULATOR ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Remove the door glass (see page ED-10).
WS
WS–48
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
(b) Operate the front door window regulator using the
switch.
(c) Check that the power window regulator operates
smoothly.
OK:
Power window regulator operates smoothly.
NG
OK
REPLACE DOOR GLASS RUN
WS
REPLACE POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
ASSEMBLY LH
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
WS–49
Jam Protection Function does not Operate
DESCRIPTION
The power window regulator master switch controls the driver side power window regulator motor. The
jam protection function only operates within a specified range during AUTO UP operation or key-off
manual UP operation.
HINT:
The jam protection function is only available on the driver side power window.
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
RESET POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR FRONT LH (DRIVER SIDE)
(a) Reset the power window regulator motor (see page WS7).
(b) Check if the power window AUTO UP / DOWN function
operates normally.
OK:
AUTO UP / DOWN function operates normally.
NG
OTHER PROBLEM
OK
2
CHECK JAM PROTECTION FUNCTION OPERATING RANGE
(a) Check that the jam protection function operates normally
(see page WS-14).
HINT:
The jam protection function does not operate from the
fully closed position of the door glass to 4 mm (0.16 in.)
below that.
OK:
Jam protection function operates normally.
NG
OK
END
REPLACE POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
MASTER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
WS
WS–50
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
Manual Up / Down Function does not Operate on Driver Side
DESCRIPTION
If the manual UP / DOWN function does not operate, a malfunction may be present in the power window
regulator master switch assembly, the power window regulator motor or the wire harness.
WIRING DIAGRAM
Power Window Regulator
Motor Front LH
Power Window Regulator
Master Switch
U
DU
M
DD
D
from IG1 Relay
BDR
from Battery
BW
E
to Body Ground
E124636E01
WS
INSPECTION PROCEDURE
1
CHECK POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MASTER SWITCH ASSEMBLY (BW, BDR
VOLTAGE)
(a) Disconnect the P17 switch connector.
(b) Measure the voltage of the wire harness side connector.
Standard voltage
Wire Harness Side
E
BW
Tester Connection
P17
OK
E124648E02
Specified Condition
P17-7 (BW) - P17-1 (E)
Always
10 to 14 V
P17-11 (BDR) - P17-1 (E)
Power switch ON (IG)
10 to 14 V
NG
BDR
Condition
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR (BATTERY - MASTER SWITCH)
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW CONTROL SYSTEM
2
WS–51
CHECK POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR ASSEMBLY FRONT LH
Wire Harness Side
Power Window Regulator Master Switch
P17
DD
DU
BW
E124648E03
(a) Disconnect the P17 switch connector.
(b) Using a service wire, connect the terminals according to
the table below.
(c) Check operation of the power window regulator motor.
OK
Wire Connection
Specified Condition
P17-4 (DU) - P17-7 (BW)
P17-9 (DD) - Body ground
Power window moves UP
P17-4 (DU) - Body ground
P17-7 (BW) - P17-9 (DD)
Power window moves DOWN
OK
REPLACE POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
MASTER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
NG
3
CHECK WIRE HARNESS (MASTER SWITCH - REGULATOR MOTOR)
Wire Harness Side
Power Window Regulator Master Switch
DU
DD
P17
(a) Disconnect the P17 switch connector.
(b) Disconnect the P18 motor connector.
(c) Measure the resistance of the wire harness side
connectors.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Specified Condition
P17-9 (DD) - P18-1 (D)
Below 1 Ω
P17-4 (DU) - P18-2 (U)
Below 1 Ω
P17-9 (DD) or P18-1 (D) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
P17-4 (DU) or P18-2 (U) - Body
ground
10 kΩ or higher
NG
REPAIR OR REPLACE HARNESS AND
CONNECTOR
Power Window Regulator Motor Front LH
D
P18
U
1
2
3 4 5 6
E124630E04
OK
REPLACE POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR ASSEMBLY FRONT LH
WS
WS–49
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW MASTER SWITCH
POWER WINDOW MASTER
SWITCH
INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MASTER
SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Measure the resistance of the switch when the
switch is operated.
Window Lock Switch
Front Passenger Switch
PD
PU
Rear RH Switch
RRD
RLU
RRU
RLD
Driver Switch
DD
Rear LH Switch
E
DU
B
BW
E124624E01
Standard resistance:
Driver switch
Tester Connection
Window Lock Switch Condition
Power Window Switch
Condition
Specified Condition
1 (E) - 9 (DD)
Always
(ON / OFF)
UP
Below 1 Ω
Always
(ON / OFF)
AUTO UP
Below 1 Ω
Always
(ON / OFF)
OFF
Below 1 Ω
Always
(ON / OFF)
DOWN
Below 1 Ω
Always
(ON / OFF)
AUTO DOWN
Below 1 Ω
4 (DU) - 7 (BW)
1 (E) - 9 (DD)
4 (DU) - 7 (BW)
1 (E) - 4 (DU)
1 (E) - 9 (DD)
1 (E) - 4 (DU)
7 (BW) - 9 (DD)
1 (E) - 4 (DU)
7 (BW) - 9 (DD)
Passenger switch
Tester Connection
Window Lock Switch Condition
Power Window Switch
Condition
Specified Condition
1 (E) - 15 (PD)
OFF
UP
Below 1 Ω
OFF
OFF
Below 1 Ω
OFF
DOWN
Below 1 Ω
ON
UP
10 kΩ or higher
ON
OFF
6 (B) - 13 (PU)
1 (E) - 13 (PU)
1 (E) - 15 (PD)
1 (E) - 13 (PU)
6 (B) - 15 (PD)
1 (E) - 15 (PD)
Below 1 Ω
6 (B) - 13 (PU)
13 (PU) - 15 (PD)
Below 1 Ω
WS
WS–50
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW MASTER SWITCH
Tester Connection
Window Lock Switch Condition
Power Window Switch
Condition
1 (E) - 13 (PU)
ON
DOWN
Specified Condition
10 kΩ or higher
Below 1 Ω
6 (B) - 15 (PD)
Rear LH switch
Tester Connection
Window Lock Switch Condition
Power Window Switch
Condition
Specified Condition
1 (E) - 10 (RLD)
OFF
UP
Below 1 Ω
OFF
OFF
Below 1 Ω
OFF
DOWN
Below 1 Ω
ON
UP
10 kΩ or higher
12 (RLU) - 10 (RLD)
ON
OFF
1 (E) - 12 (RLU)
ON
DOWN
6 (B) - 12 (RLU)
1 (E) - 12 (RLU)
1 (E) - 10 (RLD)
1 (E) - 12 (RLU)
6 (B) - 10 (RLD)
1 (E) - 10 (RLD)
Below 1 Ω
6 (B) - 12 (RLU)
Below 1 Ω
10 kΩ or higher
Below 1 Ω
6 (B) - 10 (RLD)
Rear RH switch
Tester Connection
Window Lock Switch Condition
Power Window Switch
Condition
Specified Condition
1 (E) - 16 (RRD)
OFF
UP
Below 1 Ω
OFF
OFF
Below 1 Ω
OFF
DOWN
Below 1 Ω
ON
UP
6 (B) - 18 (RRU)
1 (E) - 18 (RRU)
1 (E) - 16 (RRD)
1 (E) - 18 (RRU)
6 (B) - 16 (RRD)
1 (E) - 16 (RRD)
WS
10 kΩ or higher
Below 1 Ω
6 (B) - 18 (RRU)
18 (RRU) - 16 (RRD)
ON
OFF
Below 1 Ω
1 (E) - 18 (RRU)
ON
DOWN
10 kΩ or higher
6 (B) - 16 (RRD)
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the master
switch assembly.
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW MASTER SWITCH
WS–51
(b) Apply battery voltage to the master switch and
check that the AUTO light illuminates.
Master Switch
AUTO Light
BDR
E
E124625E01
OK
Measurement Condition
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 11
(BDR)
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 1(E)
AUTO light illuminates
If the result is not as specified, replace the master
switch assembly.
WS
WS–52 WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – FRONT PASSENGER SIDE POWER WINDOW SWITCH
FRONT PASSENGER SIDE POWER
WINDOW SWITCH
INSPECTION
1.
B063163
INSPECT POWER WINDOW REGULATOR SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
(a) Measure the resistance of the switch when the
switch is operated.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
3-4
UP
Below 1 Ω
1-2
3-5
OFF
Below 1 Ω
1-4
3-5
DOWN
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the regulator
switch assembly.
WS
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – REAR POWER WINDOW SWITCH
WS–53
REAR POWER WINDOW SWITCH
INSPECTION
1.
B063163
INSPECT POWER WINDOW REGULATOR SWITCH
ASSEMBLY
(a) Measure the resistance of the switch when the
switch is operated.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
1-2
3-4
UP
Below 1 Ω
1-2
3-5
OFF
Below 1 Ω
1-4
3-5
DOWN
Below 1 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the regulator
switch assembly.
WS
WS–54
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR
Front LH and Rear LH
Counterclockwise
Clockwise
POWER WINDOW REGULATOR
MOTOR
INSPECTION
1.
Motor Gear
B086401E06
INSPECT POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR
ASSEMBLY (for Front LH and Rear LH)
(a) Apply battery voltage to connector terminals 1 and
2.
NOTICE:
Do not apply battery voltage to any terminals
except terminals 1 and 2.
(b) Check that the motor gear rotates smoothly as
follows.
OK
Measurement Condition
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 2
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 1
Motor gear rotates clockwise
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 1
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 2
Motor gear rotates counterclockwise
If the result is not as specified, replace the regulator
motor assembly.
2.
Front RH and Rear RH
Clockwise
Motor Gear
WS
Counterclockwise
B086400E05
INSPECT POWER WINDOW REGULATOR MOTOR
ASSEMBLY (for Front RH and Rear RH)
(a) Apply battery voltage to connector terminals 1 and
2.
NOTICE:
Do not apply battery voltage to any terminals
except terminals 1 and 2.
(b) Check that the motor gear rotates smoothly as
follows.
OK
Measurement Condition
Specified Condition
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 1
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 2
Motor gear rotates clockwise
Battery positive (+) → Terminal 2
Battery negative (-) → Terminal 1
Motor gear rotates counterclockwise
If the result is not as specified, replace the regulator
motor assembly.
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – WINDSHIELD GLASS
WS–55
WINDSHIELD GLASS
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS
BODY
COMPONENTS
w/ EC Mirror
INNER REAR
VIEW MIRROR
COVER
w/o EC Mirror
INNER REAR VIEW
MIRROR ASSEMBLY
NO. 1 WINDSHIELD
GLASS STOPPER
NO. 2 WINDSHIELD
GLASS STOPPER
INNER REAR VIEW
MIRROR ASSEMBLY
WINDOW GLASS
ADHESIVE DAM
WS
WINDSHIELD GLASS
WINDSHIELD MOULDING OUTSIDE
Non-reusable part
B127637E01
WS–56
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – WINDSHIELD GLASS
COWL TOP VENTILATOR
LOUVER RH
FRONT WIPER ARM RH
21 (214, 15)
COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER LH
21 (214, 15)
WS
FRONT WIPER
ARM HEAD CAP
FRONT WIPER ARM LH
HOOD TO COWL TOP SEAL
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B127638E01
WS–57
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – WINDSHIELD GLASS
ASSIST GRIP
SUB-ASSEMBLY
FRONT PILLAR
GARNISH RH
ASSIST GRIP
COVER
FRONT DOOR
OPENING TRIM
RH
FRONT PILLAR GARNISH
CORNER PIECE RH
ROOF HEADLINING
ASSEMBLY
ASSIST GRIP
COVER
FRONT DOOR
SCUFF PLATE RH
ASSIST GRIP
SUB-ASSEMBLY
COWL SIDE TRIM
BOARD RH
MAP LIGHT ASSEMBLY
WS
VISOR ASSEMBLY RH
FRONT DOOR
OPENING TRIM
LH
VISOR HOLDER
FRONT PILLAR GARNISH LH
VISOR ASSEMBLY LH
FRONT PILLAR GARNISH
CORNER PIECE LH
COWL SIDE TRIM BOARD LH
FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
B127639E01
WS–58
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – WINDSHIELD GLASS
REMOVAL
WS
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH (See page
IR-7)
3.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH (See page
IR-7)
4.
REMOVE COWL SIDE TRIM BOARD LH (See page IR7)
5.
REMOVE COWL SIDE TRIM BOARD RH (See page
IR-7)
6.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR OPENING TRIM LH
(a) Partially remove the front door opening trim
weatherstrip LH so that the front pillar garnish LH
can be removed (see page IR-7).
7.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR OPENING TRIM RH
HINT:
Use the same procedures described for the LH side.
8.
REMOVE FRONT PILLAR GARNISH CORNER PIECE
LH (See page IR-7)
9.
REMOVE FRONT PILLAR GARNISH CORNER PIECE
RH (See page IR-7)
10. REMOVE FRONT PILLAR GARNISH LH (See page IR8)
11. REMOVE FRONT PILLAR GARNISH RH (See page IR8)
12. REMOVE VISOR ASSEMBLY LH (See page IR-13)
13. REMOVE VISOR ASSEMBLY RH (See page IR-13)
14. REMOVE VISOR HOLDER (See page IR-13)
15. REMOVE ASSIST GRIP COVER (See page IR-12)
16. REMOVE ASSIST GRIP SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page
IR-13)
17. REMOVE MAP LIGHT ASSEMBLY (See page IR-12)
18. REMOVE ROOF HEADLINING ASSEMBLY
HINT:
It is not necessary to completely remove the roof
headlining. Slightly lower the front section of the roof
headlining.
(a) Partially remove the roof headlining (see page IR13).
19. REMOVE INNER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSEMBLY
(w/o EC Mirror) (See page MI-5)
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – WINDSHIELD GLASS
WS–59
20. REMOVE INNER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSEMBLY
(w/ EC Mirror) (See page MI-5)
21. REMOVE HOOD TO COWL TOP SEAL (See page
WW-13)
22. REMOVE FRONT WIPER ARM HEAD CAP
23. REMOVE FRONT WIPER ARM LH (See page WW-13)
24. REMOVE FRONT WIPER ARM RH (See page WW-13)
25. REMOVE COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER LH (See
page WW-13)
26. REMOVE COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER RH (See
page WW-13)
Cut
Moulding
Cut
Vehicle
Body
Windshield Glass
27. REMOVE WINDSHIELD MOULDING OUTSIDE
(a) Using a knife, cut off the moulding as shown in the
illustration.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the vehicle body.
(b) Remove the remaining moulding.
HINT:
Make a partial cut in the moulding. Then pull and
remove it by hand.
B050448E03
28. REMOVE WINDSHIELD GLASS
(a) Apply protective tape to the outer surface of the
vehicle body to prevent scratches.
Plastic Sheet
WS
Protective Tape
B063724E03
Stopper
Piano Wire
B073409E01
(b) From the interior, insert a piano wire between the
vehicle body and glass as shown in the illustration.
(c) Tie objects that can serve as handles (for example,
wooden blocks) to both wire ends.
NOTICE:
• When separating the glass from the vehicle,
be careful not to damage the vehicle's paint
or interior/exterior ornaments.
• To prevent the instrument panel from being
scratched when removing the glass, place a
plastic sheet between the piano wire and
instrument panel.
WS–60
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – WINDSHIELD GLASS
Matchmark
B106095E03
(d) Place matchmarks over the glass and vehicle body
on the locations indicated in the illustration.
HINT:
Matchmarks do not need to be placed if not reusing
the glass.
(e) Cut through the adhesive by pulling the piano wire
around the glass.
NOTICE:
Leave as much adhesive on the vehicle body as
possible when cutting through the adhesive.
(f) Disengage the stoppers.
(g) Using suction cups, remove the glass.
29. CLEAN WINDSHIELD GLASS
(a) Using a scraper, remove the damaged stoppers,
dams and adhesive sticking to the glass.
(b) Clean the outer edges of the glass with white
gasoline.
NOTICE:
Do not touch the glass surface after cleaning it.
Even if using new glass, clean it with white
gasoline.
B106080
Adhesive
WS
Adhesive
Vehicle Body
B106081E05
30. CLEAN VEHICLE BODY
(a) Clean and shape the contact surface of the vehicle
body.
(1) On the contact surface of the vehicle body, use
a knife to cut away excess adhesive as shown
in the illustration.
HINT:
Leave as much adhesive on the vehicle body
as possible.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the vehicle body.
(b) Clean the contact surface of the vehicle body with
cleaner.
HINT:
Even if all the adhesive has been removed, clean
the vehicle body.
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – WINDSHIELD GLASS
WS–61
INSTALLATION
1.
(b) Install 2 new stoppers onto the glass as shown in
the illustration.
Standard measurement
Backside
Stopper
Stopper
c
b
INSTALL NO. 2 WINDSHIELD GLASS STOPPER
(a) Apply Primer G to the glass where the stoppers will
be installed.
NOTICE:
• Allow the primer to dry for 3 minutes or more.
• Throw away any leftover primer.
• Do not apply too much primer.
a
Area
Specified Condition
a
40.0 mm (1.575 in.)
b
7.7 mm (0.303 in.)
c
12.5 mm (0.492 in.)
c
a
a a
b
B073410E02
2.
INSTALL NO. 1 WINDSHIELD GLASS STOPPER
(a) Install 2 new stoppers to the vehicle body as shown
in the illustration.
3.
INSTALL WINDOW GLASS ADHESIVE DAM
(a) Apply Primer G to the glass where the glass
adhesive dams will be installed.
NOTICE:
• Allow the primer to dry for 3 minutes or more.
• Throw away any leftover primer.
• Do not apply too much primer.
Stopper
Vehicle Body
B106096E03
WS
WS–62
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – WINDSHIELD GLASS
(b) Remove the peeling paper from the adhesive part of
the dam. Install the dam (adhesive side) to the glass
(Primer G area), but exclude the spacer area A as
shown in the illustration.
Backside
E
D
E
A
A
Ceramic Notch
Dam
Dam
Stopper
B
D
B
Ceramic Notch
Dam
C
Marking
Dam
Stopper
F
C
A-A
B-B
F
C-C
a
b
Dam
Ceramic
Notch
Marking
Marking
B073411E01
Standard measurement
WS
Matchmark
B106104E03
Area
Specified Condition
a
7.0 mm (0.276 in.)
b
27.5 mm (1.083 in.)
4.
INSTALL WINDSHIELD GLASS
(a) Position the glass.
(1) Using suction cups, place the glass in the
correct position.
(2) Check that the entire contact surface of the
glass rim is perfectly even.
(3) Place matchmarks on the glass and vehicle
body on the locations indicated in the
illustration.
HINT:
• Placing matchmarks is only necessary when
installing new glass. If it is the reused glass,
matchmarks should already be present.
• When reusing the glass, check and correct
the matchmark positions.
NOTICE:
Check that the stoppers are attached to the
vehicle body correctly.
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – WINDSHIELD GLASS
WS–63
(4) Using suction cups, remove the glass.
(b) Using a brush, apply Primer M to the exposed part
of the vehicle body.
NOTICE:
• Allow the primer to dry for 3 minutes or more.
• Do not apply primer to the adhesive.
• Throw away any leftover primer.
• Do not apply too much primer.
CORRECT
Primer M
Primer M
Adhesive
INCORRECT
Primer M
B106085E04
(c) Using a brush or sponge, apply Primer G to the
contact surface of the glass.
HINT:
If the primer is applied to an area that is not
specified, apply white gasoline to a clean cloth and
wipe off the excess primer.
NOTICE:
• Allow the primer to dry for 3 minutes or more.
• Throw away any leftover primer.
• Do not apply too much primer.
A
A
A A
B
B
A-A
B-B
: Primer G
B073412E03
WS
WS–64
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – WINDSHIELD GLASS
(d) Apply adhesive to the glass.
Adhesive:
Toyota Genuine Windshield Glass Adhesive or
Equivalent
(1) Cut off the tip of the cartridge nozzle as shown
in the illustration.
HINT:
After cutting off the tip, use all adhesive within
the time written in the table below.
Usage time frame
A
A
A A
B
B
c
a
A-A
a
b
b
Usage Time Frame
35°C (95°F)
15 minutes
20°C (68°F)
1 hour 40 minutes
5°C (41°F)
8 hours
(2) Load the sealer gun with the cartridge.
(3) Apply adhesive to the glass as shown in the
illustration.
Standard measurement
a
B-B
: Adhesive
Temperature
b
B073413E01
Area
Specified Condition
a
12.5 mm (0.492 in.)
b
8.0 mm (0.315 in.)
c
3.0 mm (0.118 in.)
(e) Install the glass to the vehicle body.
(1) Using suction cups, position the glass so that
the matchmarks are aligned. Press it in gently
along the rim.
(2) Lightly press the outer surface of the glass to
ensure that it is securely fit to the vehicle body.
NOTICE:
• Check that the stoppers are attached to
the vehicle body correctly.
• Check that the vehicle body and glass
have a small gap between them.
(3) Hold the glass in place securely with protective
tape or equivalent until the adhesive hardens.
Matchmark
WS
B106104E04
5.
INSTALL WINDSHIELD MOULDING OUTSIDE
(a) Using a brush or sponge, apply Primer G to the
glass where a new moulding will be installed.
NOTICE:
• Allow the primer to dry for 3 minutes or more.
• Throw away any leftover primer.
• Do not apply too much primer.
(b) Align the moulding's marks with glass notches and
install the moulding before the adhesive dries.
NOTICE:
Do not drive the vehicle for the amount of time
written in the table below.
Minimum time
Temperature
Minimum time prior to driving
vehicle
35°C (95°F)
1 hour 30 minutes
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – WINDSHIELD GLASS
Temperature
WS–65
Minimum time prior to driving
vehicle
20°C (68°F)
5 hours
5°C (41°F)
24 hours
6.
INSTALL COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER RH
7.
INSTALL COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER LH
8.
INSTALL FRONT WIPER ARM LH (See page WW-16)
9.
INSTALL FRONT WIPER ARM RH (See page WW-16)
10. INSTALL FRONT WIPER ARM HEAD CAP
11. INSTALL HOOD TO COWL TOP SEAL
12. INSTALL INNER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSEMBLY
(w/o EC Mirror) (See page MI-6)
13. REMOVE INNER REAR VIEW MIRROR ASSEMBLY
(w/ EC Mirror) (See page MI-7)
14. INSTALL ROOF HEADLINING ASSEMBLY (See page
IR-13)
15. INSTALL MAP LIGHT ASSEMBLY (See page IR-15)
16. INSTALL ASSIST GRIP SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page
IR-14)
17. INSTALL ASSIST GRIP COVER (See page IR-14)
18. INSTALL VISOR HOLDER (See page IR-14)
19. INSTALL VISOR ASSEMBLY LH (See page IR-14)
20. INSTALL VISOR ASSEMBLY RH (See page IR-14)
21. INSTALL FRONT PILLAR GARNISH LH (See page IR18)
22. INSTALL FRONT PILLAR GARNISH RH (See page IR18)
23. INSTALL FRONT PILLAR GARNISH CORNER PIECE
LH (See page IR-19)
24. INSTALL FRONT PILLAR GARNISH CORNER PIECE
RH (See page IR-19)
25. INSTALL FRONT DOOR OPENING TRIM LH
26. INSTALL FRONT DOOR OPENING TRIM RH
27. INSTALL COWL SIDE TRIM BOARD LH (See page IR19)
28. REMOVE COWL SIDE TRIM BOARD RH (See page
IR-19)
29. REMOVE FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH (See page
IR-19)
30. INSTALL FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE RH (See page
IR-19)
WS
WS–66
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – WINDSHIELD GLASS
31. CHECK FOR LEAKS AND REPAIR
(a) Conduct a leak test after the adhesive has
completely hardened.
(b) Seal any leaks with auto glass sealer.
32. CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
33. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
WS
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – FRONT SIDE FIX WINDOW GLASS
WS–67
FRONT SIDE FIX WINDOW GLASS
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS
BODY
COMPONENTS
FRONT PILLAR
GARNISH LH
FRONT DOOR
OPENING TRIM LH
FRONT PILLAR GARNISH
CORNER PIECE LH
COWL SIDE
TRIM BOARD LH
FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH
FRONT SIDE FIX WINDOW
ASSEMBLY LH
QUARTER PANEL SPACER
HOOK FASTENER
Non-reusable part
B129177E01
WS
WS–68
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – FRONT SIDE FIX WINDOW GLASS
REMOVAL
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the LH side and RH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the RH side.
Protective Tape
1.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH (See page
IR-7)
2.
REMOVE COWL SIDE TRIM BOARD LH (See page IR7)
3.
REMOVE FRONT DOOR OPENING TRIM LH
(a) Partially remove the front door opening trim
weatherstrip LH so that the front pillar garnish LH
can be removed (see page IR-7).
4.
REMOVE FRONT PILLAR GARNISH CORNER PIECE
LH (See page IR-7)
5.
REMOVE FRONT PILLAR GARNISH LH (See page IR8)
6.
REMOVE FRONT SIDE FIX WINDOW ASSEMBLY LH
NOTICE:
When removing the quarter window glass from the
vehicle, be careful not to damage the vehicle's paint
or interior/exterior ornaments.
(a) Apply protective tape to the outer surface of the
vehicle body to prevent scratches.
B073857E01
(b) Using a knife, cut off the moulding as shown in the
illustration.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the vehicle body with
the knife.
(c) Remove the remaining moulding.
HINT:
Make a partial cut in the moulding. Then pull and
remove it by hand.
WS
A
B
A
C
B
D
C
D
Moulding
A-A
Cut
B-B
Cut
Moulding
C-C
D-D
Cut
Cut
B073414E01
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – FRONT SIDE FIX WINDOW GLASS
(d) From the interior, insert a piano wire between the
vehicle body and glass as shown in the illustration.
(e) Tie objects that can serve as handles (for example,
wooden blocks) to both wire ends.
NOTICE:
To prevent the instrument panel from being
scratched when removing the glass, place a
plastic sheet between the piano wire and
instrument panel.
(f) Cut through the adhesive by pulling the piano wire
around the glass.
NOTICE:
Leave as much adhesive on the vehicle body as
possible when cutting through the adhesive.
(g) Disengage the stoppers.
(h) Using suction cup, remove the glass.
Clip
Piano Wire
Hook Fastener
B073856E01
7.
Adhesive
Vehicle Body
B073084E01
WS–69
CLEAN VEHICLE BODY
(a) Clean and shape the contact surface of the vehicle
body.
(1) On the contact surface of the vehicle body, use
a knife to cut away excess adhesive as shown
in the illustration.
HINT:
Leave as much adhesive on the vehicle body
as possible.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the vehicle body.
(b) Clean the contact surface of the vehicle body with
cleaner.
HINT:
Even if all the adhesive has been removed, clean
the vehicle body.
WS
WS–70
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – FRONT SIDE FIX WINDOW GLASS
INSTALLATION
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the LH side and RH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
• A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the
standard bolt chart (see page SS-2).
Installation Area
1.
INSTALL QUARTER PANEL SPACER
(a) Install a new spacer to the vehicle body as shown in
the illustration.
2.
INSTALL HOOK FASTENER
(a) Apply Primer G to the glass where the fastener will
be installed.
NOTICE:
• Allow the primer to dry for 3 minutes or more.
• Throw away any leftover primer.
• Do not apply too much primer.
(b) Install a new hook fastener onto the glass as shown
in the illustration.
3.
INSTALL WINDSHIELD GLASS
(a) Using a brush, apply Primer M to the exposed part
of the vehicle body.
NOTICE:
• Allow the primer to dry for 3 minutes or more.
• Do not apply primer to the adhesive.
• Throw away any leftover primer.
• Do not apply too much primer.
Vehicle Body
B073860E01
Hook Fastener
B075785E01
WS
Primer M
CORRECT
Primer M
Adhesive
INCORRECT
: Primer M
B073858E01
WS–71
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – FRONT SIDE FIX WINDOW GLASS
(b) Using a brush or sponge, apply Primer G to the
contact surface of the glass.
A-A
B-B
Marking
Marking
Marking
A
C-C
B
A
B
C
Marking
Marking
D
C
D-D
: Primer G
D
B073859E04
HINT:
If the primer is applied to an area that is not
specified, apply white gasoline to a clean cloth and
wipe off the excess primer.
NOTICE:
• Allow the primer to dry for 3 minutes or more.
• Throw away any leftover primer.
• Do not apply too much primer.
(c) Apply adhesive to the glass.
A-A
B-B
b
WS
b
A
B
a
B
A
C
a
D
C-C
D-D
b
b
C
D
a
a
b
a
b
: Adhesive
B073861E02
Adhesive:
Part No. 08850-00801 or equivalent
WS–72
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – FRONT SIDE FIX WINDOW GLASS
(1) Cut off the tip of the cartridge nozzle as shown
in the illustration.
HINT:
After cutting off the tip, use all adhesive within
the time written in the table below.
Usage time frame
Temperature
Usage Time Frame
35°C (95°F)
15 minutes
20°C (68°F)
1 hour 40 minutes
5°C (41°F)
8 hours
(2) Load the sealer gun with the cartridge.
(3) Apply adhesive to the glass as shown in the
illustration.
Standard measurement
Area
Specified Condition
a
8.0 mm (0.315 in.)
b
6.0 mm (0.236 in.)
(d) Install the front side fix window to the vehicle body.
(1) Hold the front side fix window in place securely
with protective tape or equivalent until the
adhesive hardens.
NOTICE:
• Check that the spacer is attached to the
vehicle body correctly.
• Check that the vehicle body and glass
have a small gap between them.
(2) Lightly press the front surface of the glass to
ensure that the glass is securely fit to the
vehicle body.
NOTICE:
Do not drive the vehicle for the amount of
time written in the table below.
Minimum time
WS
Temperature
Minimum time prior to driving
vehicle
35°C (95°F)
1 hour 30 minutes
20°C (68°F)
5 hours
5°C (41°F)
24 hours
4.
INSTALL FRONT PILLAR GARNISH LH (See page IR18)
5.
INSTALL FRONT PILLAR GARNISH CORNER PIECE
LH (See page IR-19)
6.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP LH
7.
INSTALL COWL SIDE TRIM BOARD LH (See page IR19)
8.
INSTALL FRONT DOOR SCUFF PLATE LH (See page
IR-19)
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – FRONT SIDE FIX WINDOW GLASS
9.
WS–73
CHECK FOR LEAKS AND REPAIR
(a) Conduct a leak test after the adhesive has
completely hardened.
(b) Seal any leaks with auto glass sealer.
WS
WS–73
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – BACK DOOR GLASS
BACK DOOR GLASS
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS
BODY
COMPONENTS
BACK DOOR GLASS
ADHESIVE DAM
BACK WINDOW
MOULDING OUTSIDE
BACK DOOR GLASS
BACK WINDOW
GLASS SPACER
BACK WINDOW
GLASS SPACER
BACK DOOR GLASS
ADHESIVE DAM
WS
BACK WINDOW
MOULDING OUTSIDE
REAR SPOILER SUB-ASSEMBLY
Non-reusable part
B127643E01
WS–74
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – BACK DOOR GLASS
BACK DOOR TRIM UPPER
PANEL ASSEMBLY
BACK DOOR SIDE
GARNISH RH
BACK DOOR SIDE
GARNISH LH
BACK DOOR UPPER TRIM
BOARD ASSEMBLY
BACK DOOR LOWER TRIM
BOARD ASSEMBLY
w/ Rear Wiper
REAR WIPER ARM ASSEMBLY
WS
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
Grommet
REAR WIPER
MOTOR ASSEMBLY
5.5 (56, 49 in.*lbf)
BACK DOOR UPPER TRIM
BOARD ASSEMBLY
N*m (kgf*cm, ft.*lbf) : Specified torque
B127642E01
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – BACK DOOR GLASS
WS–75
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE REAR WIPER ARM ASSEMBLY (w/ Rear
wiper) (See page WW-22)
3.
REMOVE BACK DOOR LOWER TRIM BOARD
ASSEMBLY (See page ED-43)
4.
REMOVE BACK DOOR UPPER TRIM BOARD
ASSEMBLY (See page ED-44)
5.
REMOVE BACK DOOR TRIM UPPER PANEL
ASSEMBLY (See page ED-44)
6.
REMOVE BACK DOOR SIDE GARNISH LH (See page
ED-44)
7.
REMOVE BACK DOOR SIDE GARNISH RH (See page
ED-44)
8.
REMOVE REAR WIPER MOTOR ASSEMBLY (w/ Rear
wiper) (See page WW-22)
9.
REMOVE REAR SPOILER SUB-ASSEMBLY (See
page ET-17)
10. REMOVE BACK DOOR GLASS
(a) Apply protective tape to the outer surface of the
vehicle body to prevent scratches.
NOTICE:
When separating the back door glass from the
vehicle, be careful not to damage the vehicle's
paint or interior/exterior ornaments.
Protective
Tape
B073869E01
Spacer
Piano Wire
B073870E01
(b) From the interior, insert a piano wire between the
vehicle body and back door glass as shown in the
illustration.
(c) Tie objects that can serve as handles (for example,
wooden blocks) to both wire ends.
(d) Cut through the adhesive by pulling the piano wire
around the back door glass.
NOTICE:
Leave as much adhesive on the vehicle body as
possible when removing the back door glass.
(e) Using suction cups, remove the back door glass.
WS
WS–76
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – BACK DOOR GLASS
11. CLEAN BACK DOOR GLASS
(a) Clean the outer edge of the back door glass with
white gasoline.
NOTICE:
• Do not touch the back door glass surface
after cleaning it.
• Be careful not to damage the glass.
• Even if using new back door glass, clean the
back door glass with white gasoline.
BO04421E02
Adhesive
Adhesive
Vehicle Body
B106081E02
WS
12. CLEAN VEHICLE BODY
(a) Using a scraper, remove the moulding and adhesive
from the back door glass.
(b) Clean and shape the contact surface of the vehicle
body.
(1) On the contact surface of the vehicle body, use
a knife to cut away excess adhesive as shown
in the illustration.
HINT:
Leave as much adhesive on the vehicle body
as possible.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the vehicle body.
(2) Clean the contact surface of the vehicle body
with cleaner.
HINT:
Even if all the adhesive has been removed,
clean the vehicle body.
WS–77
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – BACK DOOR GLASS
INSTALLATION
HINT:
A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the standard
bolt chart (see page SS-2).
Backside
Spacer
Spacer
1.
INSTALL BACK WINDOW GLASS SPACER
(a) Apply Primer G to the installation part of the
spacers.
HINT:
If primer is applied to an area that is not specified,
wipe off the primer with white gasoline before it
dries.
NOTICE:
• Allow the primer to dry for 3 minutes or more.
• Throw away any leftover primer.
• Do not apply too much primer.
(b) Install 2 new spacers onto the glass as shown in the
illustration.
2.
INSTALL BACK DOOR GLASS ADHESIVE DAM
(a) Apply Primer G to the glass where the adhesive
dam will be installed.
NOTICE:
• Allow the primer to dry for 3 minutes or more.
• Throw away any leftover primer.
• Do not apply too much primer.
(b) Remove the peeling paper from the adhesive part of
the dam. Install the dam (adhesive side) to the glass
(Primer G area) as shown in the illustration.
B073871E03
Backside
A
A
Reference
Mark
WS
Reference
Mark
Installation Area
B-B
A-A
B
B
: Primer G
B073872E01
3.
INSTALL BACK WINDOW MOULDING OUTSIDE
(a) Using a brush or sponge, apply Primer G to the
contact surface of the back door glass.
Backside
A
A
A
A
a
A-A
B076573E01
WS–78
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – BACK DOOR GLASS
NOTICE:
• Allow the primer to dry for 3 minutes or more.
• Throw away any leftover primer.
• Do not apply too much primer.
Standard measurement
Area
Specified Condition
a
10.0 mm (0.394 in.)
(b) Install the moulding.
Backside
A
B
A
a
Reference
Mark
b
b
Reference
Mark
c
B
B076574E01
Standard measurement
Area
Specified Condition
a
4.5 mm (0.177 in.)
b
1.5 mm (0.059 in.)
c
24.2 mm (0.953 in.)
4.
CORRECT
Primer M
WS
Primer M
Adhesive
INCORRECT
Primer M
B074627E03
INSTALL BACK DOOR GLASS
(a) Using a brush, coat the exposed part of the vehicle
body with Primer M.
NOTICE:
• Allow the primer to dry for 3 minutes or more.
• Do not coat the adhesive with Primer.
• Throw away any leftover primer.
• Do not apply too much primer.
WS–79
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – BACK DOOR GLASS
(b) Using a brush or sponge, coat the edge of the glass
and the contact surface with Primer G.
Backside
Marking
Marking
A
D
B-B
A-A
A
Marking
C-C
B
B
Marking
E
D
C
E
C
Ceramic Notch
: Primer G
Marking
Ceramic Notch
B073873E01
HINT:
If Primer G is applied to an area other than that
which is specified, wipe off the primer with cloth
before it dries.
NOTICE:
• Allow the primer to dry for 3 minutes or more.
• Throw away any leftover primer.
• Do not apply too much primer.
(c) Apply adhesive to the back door glass.
Backside
c
a
a
A
A
b
b
A-A
B-B
a
B
B
D
D
b C-C
C
a
C
b
: Adhesive
D-D
a
b
B073874E01
WS
WS–80
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – BACK DOOR GLASS
Adhesive:
Toyota Genuine Windshield Glass Adhesive or
Equivalent
(1) Cut off the tip of the cartridge nozzle as shown
in the illustration.
HINT:
After cutting off the tip, use all adhesive within
the time written in the table below.
Usage time frame
Temperature
Usage Time Frame
35°C (95°F)
15 minutes
20°C (68°F)
1 hour 40 minutes
5°C (41°F)
8 hours
(2) Load the sealer gun with the cartridge.
(3) Apply adhesive to the back door glass as
shown in the illustration.
Standard measurement
Area
Specified Condition
a
12.0 mm (0.472 in.)
b
8.0 mm (0.315 in.)
c
14.5 mm (0.571 in.)
(d) Install the back door glass to the vehicle body.
(1) Hold the back window glass in place securely
with tape or equivalent until the adhesive has
hardened.
NOTICE:
• Check that the spacers are attached to
the vehicle body correctly.
• Check that the vehicle body and glass
have a small gap between them.
(2) Lightly press the front surface of the back door
glass to ensure that the back door glass is
securely fit to the vehicle body.
WS
(3) Using a scraper, remove any excess or
protruding adhesive.
HINT:
Apply adhesive onto the glass rim.
NOTICE:
Do not drive the vehicle within the time
written in the table below.
Minimum time
Adhesive
Temperature
Minimum time prior to driving
vehicle
35°C (95°F)
1 hour 30 minutes
20°C (68°F)
5 hours
5°C (41°F)
24 hours
BO03986E06
5.
INSTALL REAR SPOILER SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page
ET-17)
6.
INSTALL REAR WIPER MOTOR ASSEMBLY (See
page WW-22)
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – BACK DOOR GLASS
WS–81
7.
INSTALL BACK DOOR SIDE GARNISH LH (See page
ED-47)
8.
INSTALL BACK DOOR SIDE GARNISH RH (See page
ED-47)
9.
INSTALL BACK DOOR TRIM UPPER PANEL
ASSEMBLY (See page ED-47)
10. INSTALL BACK DOOR UPPER TRIM BOARD
ASSEMBLY (See page ED-48)
11. INSTALL BACK DOOR LOWER TRIM BOARD
ASSEMBLY (See page ED-48)
12. INSTALL REAR WIPER ARM ASSEMBLY (w/ Rear
wiper) (See page WW-22)
13. CHECK FOR LEAKS AND REPAIR
(a) Conduct a leak test after the adhesive has
completely hardened.
(b) Seal any leaks with auto glass sealer.
14. CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
15. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
WS
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – BACK WINDOW FIX GLASS
WS–81
BACK WINDOW FIX GLASS
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS
BODY
COMPONENTS
w/ Rear Wiper
BACK DOOR UPPER TRIM
BOARD ASSEMBLY
BACK DOOR UPPER TRIM
BOARD ASSEMBLY
REAR SPOILER SUB-ASSEMBLY
BACK WINDOW
MOULDING
OUTSIDE
BACK DOOR GLASS
ADHESIVE DAM
BACK WINDOW
GLASS SPACER
WS
BACK WINDOW
MOULDING OUTSIDE
BACK WINDOW
MOULDING OUTSIDE
BACK WINDOW
GLASS SPACER
BACK DOOR OUTSIDE
GARNISH SUB-ASSEMBLY
BACK DOOR LOWER TRIM BOARD ASSEMBLY
Non-reusable part
B127644E01
WS–82
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – BACK WINDOW FIX GLASS
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE BACK DOOR LOWER TRIM BOARD
ASSEMBLY (See page ED-43)
2.
REMOVE BACK DOOR UPPER TRIM BOARD
ASSEMBLY (See page ED-44)
3.
REMOVE BACK DOOR OUTSIDE GARNISH SUBASSEMBLY (See page ET-37)
4.
REMOVE REAR SPOILER SUB-ASSEMBLY (See
page ET-17)
5.
REMOVE BACK DOOR GLASS
(a) Apply protective tape to the outer surface of the
vehicle body to prevent scratches.
NOTICE:
When separating the back door glass from the
vehicle, be careful not to damage the vehicle's
paint or interior/exterior ornaments.
Protective Tape
B073876E04
(b) From the interior, insert a piano wire between the
vehicle body and back door glass as shown in the
illustration.
(c) Tie objects that can serve as handles (for example,
wooden blocks) to both wire ends.
(d) Cut through the adhesive by pulling the piano wire
around the back door glass.
NOTICE:
Leave as much adhesive on the vehicle body as
possible when removing the back door glass.
(e) Using suction cups, remove the back door glass.
Piano Wire
Spacer
WS
Spacer
B073875E01
6.
BO04421E02
CLEAN BACK DOOR GLASS
(a) Clean the outer edge of the back door glass with
white gasoline.
NOTICE:
• Do not touch the back door glass surface
after cleaning it.
• Be careful not to damage the glass.
• Even if using new back door glass, clean the
back door glass with white gasoline.
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – BACK WINDOW FIX GLASS
Adhesive
7.
Adhesive
Vehicle Body
B106081E02
WS–83
CLEAN VEHICLE BODY
(a) Using a scraper, remove the moulding and adhesive
from the back door glass.
(b) Clean and shape the contact surface of the vehicle
body.
(1) On the contact surface of the vehicle body, use
a knife to cut away excess adhesive as shown
in the illustration.
HINT:
Leave as much adhesive on the vehicle body
as possible.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the vehicle body.
(2) Clean the contact surface of the vehicle body
with cleaner.
HINT:
Even if all the adhesive has been removed,
clean the vehicle body.
WS
WS–84
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – BACK WINDOW FIX GLASS
INSTALLATION
HINT:
A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the standard
bolt chart (see page SS-2).
1.
Backside
Spacer
INSTALL BACK WINDOW GLASS SPACER
(a) Apply Primer G to the installation part of the
spacers.
HINT:
If primer is applied to an area that is not specified,
wipe off the primer with white gasoline before it
dries.
(b) Install 2 new spacers onto the glass as shown in the
illustration.
NOTICE:
• Allow the primer to dry for 3 minutes or more.
• Throw away any leftover primer.
• Do not apply too much primer.
Spacer
2.
Spacer
B073877E02
INSTALL BACK DOOR GLASS ADHESIVE DAM
(a) Apply Primer G to the glass where the adhesive
dam will be installed.
NOTICE:
• Allow the primer to dry for 3 minutes or more.
• Throw away any leftover primer.
• Do not apply too much primer.
(b) Remove the peeling paper from the adhesive part of
the dam. Install the dam (adhesive side) to the glass
(Primer G area) as shown in the illustration.
Reference Mark
WS
B
C
Installation Area
B
A
C
A
A-A
B073878E01
WS–85
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – BACK WINDOW FIX GLASS
3.
INSTALL BACK WINDOW MOULDING OUTSIDE
Backside
A
A
A
a
A
B
b
A-A
B-B
B
B076571E01
(a) Using a brush or sponge, apply Primer G to the
contact surface of the back door glass.
NOTICE:
• Allow the primer to dry for 3 minutes or more.
• Throw away any leftover primer.
• Do not apply too much primer.
Standard measurement
Area
Specified Condition
a
10.0 mm (0.394 in.)
b
9.0 mm (0.354 in.)
(b) Install the moulding as shown in the illustration.
Backside
A
B
b
A
a
a
d
B
c
B076572E02
Standard measurement
Area
Specified Condition
a
0 mm (0 in.)
b
3.0 mm (0.118 in.)
c
1.5 mm (0.059 in.)
d
6.5 mm (0.256 in.)
4.
INSTALL BACK DOOR OUTSIDE GARNISH SUBASSEMBLY (See page ET-38)
WS
WS–86
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – BACK WINDOW FIX GLASS
5.
CORRECT
Primer M
Primer M
Adhesive
INSTALL BACK WINDOW FIX GLASS
(a) Using a brush or sponge, apply Primer M to the
exposed part of the vehicle body.
NOTICE:
• Allow the primer to dry for 3 minutes or more.
• Do not apply primer to the adhesive.
• Throw away any leftover primer.
• Do not apply too much primer.
(b) Using a brush or sponge, apply Primer G to the
contact surface of the back door glass.
INCORRECT
Primer M
B074628E03
Marking
Marking
A
WS
D
Marking
A
C
B
B
C
B-B
A-A
Marking
C-C
E
D
Marking
Ceramic Notch
: Primer G
E
Marking
Ceramic Notch
B073879E01
HINT:
If primer is applied to an area that is not specified,
wipe off the primer with white gasoline before it
dries.
NOTICE:
• Allow the primer to dry for 3 minutes or more.
• Throw away any leftover primer.
• Do not apply too much primer.
WS–87
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – BACK WINDOW FIX GLASS
(c) Apply adhesive to the back door glass.
Backside
A
A
C
B
B
B-B
A-A
a
a
C
b
b
b
C-C
a
a
b
b
: Adhesive
B073880E01
Adhesive:
Toyota Genuine Windshield Glass Adhesive or
Equivalent
(1) Cut off the tip of the cartridge nozzle as shown
in the illustration.
HINT:
After cutting off the tip, use all adhesive within
the time written in the table below.
Usage time frame
Temperature
Usage Time Frame
35°C (95°F)
15 minutes
20°C (68°F)
1 hour 40 minutes
5°C (41°F)
8 hours
(2) Load the sealer gun with the cartridge.
(3) Apply adhesive to the back door glass as
shown in the illustration.
Standard measurement
Area
Specified Condition
a
12.0 mm (0.472 in.)
b
8.0 mm (0.315 in.)
(d) Install the back window fix glass to the vehicle body.
(1) Hold the back window glass in place securely
with tape or equivalent until the adhesive has
hardened.
NOTICE:
• Check that the clips are attached to the
vehicle body correctly.
• Check the clearance between the vehicle
body and glass.
WS
WS–88
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – BACK WINDOW FIX GLASS
(2) Lightly press the front surface of the back door
glass to ensure that the back door glass is
securely fit to the vehicle body.
(3) Using a scraper, remove any excess or
protruding adhesive.
HINT:
Apply adhesive onto the glass rim.
NOTICE:
Do not drive the vehicle within the time
written in the table below.
Minimum time
Adhesive
Temperature
Minimum time prior to driving
vehicle
35°C (95°F)
1 hour 30 minutes
20°C (68°F)
5 hours
5°C (41°F)
24 hours
BO03986E06
6.
INSTALL REAR SPOILER SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page
ET-17)
7.
INSTALL BACK DOOR UPPER TRIM BOARD
ASSEMBLY (See page ED-48)
8.
INSTALL BACK DOOR LOWER TRIM BOARD
ASSEMBLY (See page ED-48)
9.
CHECK FOR LEAKS AND REPAIR
(a) Conduct a leak test after the adhesive has
completely hardened.
(b) Seal any leaks with auto glass sealer.
10. CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
WS
11. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – WINDOW DEFOGGER SYSTEM
WS–89
WINDOW DEFOGGER SYSTEM
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS
BODY
PARTS LOCATION
Steering Wheel (Steering Pad Switch)
w/ Rear Wiper
DEFOGGER
SWITCH
OUTER REAR VIEW
MIRROR LH
OUTER REAR VIEW MIRROR RH
MIRROR HEATER
RELAY
WINDOW DEFOGGER
WIRE
WS
DRIVER SIDE JUNCTION
BLOCK
- DEF RELAY
- DEF H-FUSE
- A/C (HTR) FUSE
- GAUGE FUSE
- M/HTR FUSE
- ECU-B FUSE
Multi-display
REAR DEFOGGER SWITCH
B127645E01
WS–90
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – WINDOW DEFOGGER SYSTEM
WS
ENGINE ROOM JUNCTION BLOCK, RELAY BLOCK
- DOME FUSE
B127646E01
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – WINDOW DEFOGGER SYSTEM
WS–91
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
Outer Rear View Mirror RH
Outer Rear View Mirror LH
Mirror Heater
Mirror Heater
Relay
Mirror Heater
DEF Relay
Rear Defogger
Combination Meter
Air Conditioning
ECU
Rear DEF
Indicator Light
Meter ECU
BEAN
Gateway ECU
WS
7.5
Multi-display
Steering Pad
Switch
REAR
Rear Defogger Switch
Rear Defogger Switch
B127649E02
WS–92
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – WINDOW DEFOGGER SYSTEM
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
The defogger system uses the heater wire in the rear
windshield glass to defog the rear windshield glass. The
circuit of this system is shared with the outside rear view
mirror heater system, which operates in the same manner.
WS
WS–93
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – WINDOW DEFOGGER SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
The window defogger system is part of the large-scale
multiplex communication system. This system features
shared communication wiring that reduces the wiring
complexity of the communication lines. The first step in any
repair is to confirm the proper operation of the communication
system. Proceed with troubleshooting after the
communication has been verified (see the multiplex
communication system).
Window defogger system
Symptom
Rear window defogger does not operate (Indicator
ON)
Rear window defogger does not operate (Indicator
OFF)
Mirror heater does not operate (Indicator ON)
Mirror heater does not operate (Indicator OFF)
Suspected area
See page
1. DEF H-fuse
WS-89
2. A/C (HTR) fuse
WS-89
3. GAUGE fuse
WS-55
4. DOME fuse
WS-55
5. ECU-B fuse
WS-55
6. DEF relay
WS-94
7. Rear window defogger wire
WS-95
8. Wire harness
-
1. DEF H-fuse
WS-89
2. A/C (HTR) fuse
WS-89
3. GAUGE fuse
WS-89
4. DOME fuse
WS-89
5. ECU-B fuse
WS-89
6. DEF relay
WS-94
7. Combination meter
ME-14
8. Steering pad switch
WS-93
9. Multi-display assembly
AC-26
10. Rear window defogger wire
WS-95
11. Wire harness
-
1. M/HTR fuse
WS-89
2. A/C (HTR) fuse
WS-89
3. GAUGE fuse
WS-89
4. DOME fuse
WS-89
5. ECU-B fuse
WS-89
6. Mirror heater relay
MI-15
7. Outer rear view mirror assembly
MI-10
8. Wire harness
-
1. M/HTR fuse
WS-89
2. A/C (HTR) fuse
WS-89
3. GAUGE fuse
WS-89
4. DOME fuse
WS-89
5. ECU-B fuse
WS-89
6. Mirror heater relay
MI-15
7. Combination meter
AC-26
8. Steering pad switch
WS-93
9. Multi-display assembly
AC-23
10. Outer rear view mirror assembly
MI-10
11. Wire harness
-
WS
WS–94
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – WINDOW DEFOGGER SYSTEM
INSPECTION
1.
CHECK STEERING PAD SWITCH
(a) Remove the horn button (see page SR-8).
(b) Disconnect the connector as shown in the
illustration.
B076011E01
AC1
EAC
(c) Measure the resistance of the switch.
Standard resistance
Tester Connection
Switch Condition
Specified Condition
3 (AC1) - 7 (EAC)
OFF
29 to 31 kΩ
3 (AC1) - 7 (EAC)
ON
290 to 305 Ω
If the result is not as specified, replace the switch.
B075103E04
WS
WS–94
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – DEFOGGER RELAY
DEFOGGER RELAY
Driver Side Junction Block
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
CHECK DEFOGGER (DEF) RELAY
(a) Remove the instrument panel lower (see page IP17).
(b) Measure the voltage.
Standard voltage
Terminal Connection
Condition
Specified Condition
1J-2 - Body ground
Power switch ON (IG)
Defogger switch ON
10 to 14 V
1J-2 - Body ground
Power switch ON (IG)
Defogger switch OFF
0V
1J
If the result is not as specified, the driver side
junction block may have a malfunction.
1J
B079061E02
WS
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – WINDOW DEFOGGER WIRE
Tester Probe
Defogger Wire
WS–95
WINDOW DEFOGGER WIRE
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
Tin Foil
B066134E07
INSPECT BACK DOOR GLASS (DEFOGGER WIRE)
NOTICE:
• When cleaning the glass, wipe the glass along the
wire using a soft, dry cloth. Take care not to
damage the defogger wires.
• Do not use detergents or glass cleaners that have
abrasive ingredients.
• When measuring voltage, wrap a piece of tin foil
around the tip of the negative (-) tester probe and
press the foil against the wire with your finger, as
shown in the illustration.
(a) Turn the power switch ON (IG).
(b) Press the defogger switch ON.
(c) Measure the voltage at the center of each defogger
wire as shown in the illustration.
Standard voltage
At Center
Voltage
Criteria
Approx. 5 V
Wire is not broken
Approx. 10 or 0 V
Wire is broken
WS
B119840E01
Ground Side
Foil Strip
Less than 10 V
0V
Broken Wire
Battery Side
B119841E01
HINT:
If there is approximately 10 V, the wire may be faulty
between the center of the wire and the wire end on
the battery side. If there is no voltage, the wire may
be faulty between the center of the wire end and the
wire end on the ground side.
(d) Place the voltmeter's positive (+) lead against the
defogger wire on the battery side.
(e) Place the voltmeter's negative (-) lead with the foil
strip against the wire on the ground side.
(f) Slide the positive (+) lead from the battery side to
the ground side.
(g) The point where the voltage drops from
approximately 10 V to 0 V is where the defogger
wire is broken.
HINT:
If the defogger wire is not broken, the voltmeter
indicates 0 V at the positive (+) end of the defogger
wire and gradually increases to approximately 12 V
as the meter probe moves to the other end.
WS–96
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – WINDOW DEFOGGER WIRE
REPAIR
Repair Point
Masking Tape
1.
Broken
Wire
REPAIR DEFOGGER WIRE
(a) Clean the broken wire tips with grease, wax and
silicone remover.
(b) Place masking tape along both sides of the wire.
(c) Thoroughly mix the repair agent.
Dupont paste:
No. 4817 or equivalent
B063722E05
(d) Using a fine tip brush, apply a small amount of the
agent to the wire.
(e) After a few minutes, remove the masking tape.
NOTICE:
Do not repair the defogger wire again for at least
24 hours.
Fine Tip Brush
Repair Point
B063723E03
WS
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – QUARTER WINDOW GLASS
WS–97
QUARTER WINDOW GLASS
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS
BODY
COMPONENTS
REAR SIDE SEATBACK
FRAME LH
REAR SIDE SEATBACK
FRAME RH
REAR SEAT CUSHION
ASSEMBLY
REAR DOOR OPENING
TRIM WEATHERSTRIP
LH
TONNEAU COVER
ASSEMBLY
QUARTER WINDOW
ASSEMBLY RH
WS
REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP LH
BACK DOOR
WEATHERSTRIP
ROOF SIDE INNER
GARNISH ASSEMBLY RH
QUARTER WINDOW
ASSEMBLY LH
ROOF SIDE INNER
GARNISH ASSEMBLY LH
Non-reusable part
B127640E01
WS–98
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – QUARTER WINDOW GLASS
REAR NO. 1 FLOOR BOARD
DECK TRIM SIDE
PANEL ASSEMBLY RH
REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD
REAR NO. 4 FLOOR BOARD
WS
REAR NO. 3
FLOOR BOARD
REAR DECK FLOOR BOX
DECK FLOOR BOX LH
REAR DECK TRIM COVER
DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY LH
B127641E01
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – QUARTER WINDOW GLASS
WS–99
REMOVAL
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the LH side and RH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
REMOVE REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY (See
page SE-15)
2.
REMOVE REAR SIDE SEATBACK FRAME LH (See
page IR-9)
3.
REMOVE REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP LH
4.
REMOVE BACK DOOR WEATHERSTRIP
5.
REMOVE TONNEAU COVER ASSEMBLY
6.
REMOVE REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD
7.
REMOVE REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD
8.
REMOVE REAR NO. 4 FLOOR BOARD
9.
REMOVE REAR DECK FLOOR BOX
10. REMOVE DECK FLOOR BOX LH
11. REMOVE REAR NO. 1 FLOOR BOARD (See page IR10)
12. REMOVE REAR DECK TRIM COVER (See page IR-10)
13. REMOVE DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY LH
(See page IR-11)
14. REMOVE ROOF SIDE INNER GARNISH ASSEMBLY
LH (See page IR-11)
Protective Tape
B073865E01
15. REMOVE QUARTER WINDOW ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Apply protective tape to the outer surface of the
vehicle body to prevent scratches.
NOTICE:
When removing the quarter window glass from
the vehicle, be careful not to damage the
vehicle's paint or interior/exterior ornaments.
WS
WS–100
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – QUARTER WINDOW GLASS
B
B
A
A
C
D
C
(b) Using a knife, cut off the moulding as shown in the
illustration.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the vehicle body with
the knife.
(c) Remove the remaining moulding.
HINT:
Make a partial cut in the moulding. Then pull and
remove it by hand.
D
A-A
Cut
C-C
Cut
B-B
Cut
D-D
Cut
B073863E02
Piano Wire
Clip
Clip
Clip
B073864E01
WS
Adhesive
Adhesive
Vehicle Body
B106081E09
(d) From the interior, insert a piano wire between the
vehicle body and the quarter window glass as
shown in the illustration.
(e) Tie objects that can serve as handles (for example,
wooden blocks) to both wire ends.
(f) Cut through the adhesive by pulling the piano wire
around the quarter window glass.
NOTICE:
Leave as much adhesive on the vehicle body as
possible when removing the quarter window
glass.
(g) Using suction cups, remove the quarter window
glass.
16. CLEAN VEHICLE BODY
(a) Clean and shape the contact surface of the vehicle
body.
(1) On the contact surface of the vehicle body, use
a knife to cut away excess adhesive as shown
in the illustration.
HINT:
Leave as much adhesive on the vehicle body
as possible.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to damage the vehicle body.
(2) Clean the contact surface of the vehicle body
with cleaner.
HINT:
Even if all the adhesive has been removed,
clean the vehicle body.
WS–101
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – QUARTER WINDOW GLASS
INSTALLATION
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the LH side and RH side.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
• A bolt without a torque specification is shown in the
standard bolt chart (see page SS-2).
1.
INSTALL QUARTER WINDOW ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Using a brush or sponge, apply primer M to the
exposed part of the vehicle body.
NOTICE:
• Allow the primer coating to dry for 3 minutes
or more.
• Throw away any leftover primer.
• Do not apply too much primer.
(b) Using a brush or sponge, apply primer G to the
contact surface of the glass.
CORRECT
Primer M
Primer M
Adhesive
INCORRECT
: Primer M
B073866E01
Backside
Marking
B
Marking
B
A-A
C
A
A
Marking
WS
Marking
B-B
Marking
C
D
D
C-C
D-D
: Primer G
B073867E01
HINT:
If primer is applied to an area that is specified, wipe
off the primer with white gasoline before it dries.
NOTICE:
• Allow the primer to dry for 3 minutes or more.
• Throw away any leftover primer.
• Do not apply too much primer.
WS–102
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – QUARTER WINDOW GLASS
(c) Apply adhesive to the quarter window glass.
Adhesive:
Toyota Genuine Windshield Glass Adhesive or
Equivalent
(1) Cut off the tip of the cartridge nozzle as shown
in the illustration.
A
b
b
A
a
a
C
B
D
B
b
C
B-B
A-A
D
b
b
a
a
a
C-C
b
D-D
: Adhesive
B073868E03
Standard measurement
WS
Area
Specified Condition
a
12.0 mm (0.472 in.)
b
8.0 mm (0.315 in.)
HINT:
After cutting off the tip, use all adhesive within
the time written in the table below.
Usage time frame
Temperature
Usage Time Frame
35°C (95°F)
15 minutes
20°C (68°F)
1 hour 40 minutes
5°C (41°F)
8 hours
(2) Load the sealer gun with the cartridge.
(3) Apply adhesive to the quarter window glass as
shown in the illustration.
(d) Install the quarter window glass to the vehicle body.
(1) Hold the quarter window glass in place
securely with protective tape or equivalent until
the adhesive hardens.
NOTICE:
• Allow the primer coating to dry for 3
minutes or more.
• Check that the clips are attached to the
body correctly.
WINDSHIELD / WINDOWGLASS – QUARTER WINDOW GLASS
WS–103
• Check the clearance between the body
and glass.
(2) Lightly press the front surface of the glass to
ensure a close fit.
(3) Using a scraper, remove any excess or
protruding adhesive.
HINT:
Apply adhesive onto the glass rim.
NOTICE:
Do not drive the vehicle within the time
written in the table below.
Minimum time
Adhesive
Temperature
Minimum time prior to driving
vehicle
35°C (95°F)
1 hour 30 minutes
BO03986E05
20°C (68°F)
5 hours
5°C (41°F)
24 hours
2.
INSTALL ROOF SIDE INNER GARNISH ASSEMBLY
LH (See page IR-15)
3.
INSTALL DECK TRIM SIDE PANEL ASSEMBLY LH
(See page IR-15)
4.
INSTALL REAR DECK TRIM COVER (See page IR-16)
5.
INSTALL REAR NO. 1 FLOOR BOARD (See page IR16)
6.
INSTALL DECK FLOOR BOX LH
7.
INSTALL REAR DECK FLOOR BOX
8.
INSTALL REAR NO. 4 FLOOR BOARD
9.
INSTALL REAR NO. 3 FLOOR BOARD
10. INSTALL REAR NO. 2 FLOOR BOARD
11. INSTALL TONNEAU COVER ASSEMBLY
12. INSTALL BACK DOOR WEATHERSTRIP
13. INSTALL REAR DOOR OPENING TRIM
WEATHERSTRIP LH
14. INSTALL REAR SIDE SEATBACK FRAME LH (See
page IR-17)
15. INSTALL REAR SEAT CUSHION ASSEMBLY (See
page SE-23)
16. CHECK FOR LEAKS AND REPAIR
(a) Conduct a leak test after the adhesive has
completely hardened.
(b) Seal any leaks with auto glass sealer.
WS
WIPER AND WASHER – WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
WW–1
WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
PRECAUTION
1.
PRECAUTION FOR WASHER NOZZLE (for 4 Way
Type) HANDLING
(a) Do not adjust the washer nozzle with a safety pin,
etc. as the washer nozzle tip is made of resin and
could be damaged. Be sure to use SST for
adjustment.
SST 95060-10010
(b) When the washer nozzle is clogged with wax, etc.,
do not use metal objects such as a safety pin to
clean the washer nozzle hole. Be sure to use a soft
resin brush, etc.
NOTICE:
For Initialization:
When disconnecting the cable from the negative
(-) battery terminal, initialize the following
systems after the cable is reconnected.
System Name
See page
Power Window Control System
Initialization WS-7
NOTICE:
• When the warning light is illuminated or the
battery has been disconnected and
reconnected, pressing the power switch may
not start the system on the first try. If so,
press the power switch again.
• With the power switch's power mode
changed to ON (IG), disconnect the battery. If
the key is not in the key slot during
reconnection, DTC B2799 may be output.
WW
WW–2
WIPER AND WASHER – WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
PARTS LOCATION
FRONT WASHER NOZZLE
SUB-ASSEMBLY
WW
FRONT WIPER MOTOR
WINDSHIELD WASHER MOTOR
AND PUMP ASSEMBLY
REAR WIPER MOTOR ASSEMBLY
REAR WASHER NOZZLE SUB-ASSEMBLY
WINDSHIELD WIPER RELAY ASSEMBLY
B139877E01
WIPER AND WASHER – WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
WW–3
WIPER AND WASHER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
WW
INSTRUMENT PANEL
JUNCTION BLOCK ASSEMBLY
- IG1 RELAY
- WSH FUSE
- WIP FUSE
B139878E01
WW–4
WIPER AND WASHER – WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
SYSTEM DIAGRAM
Front Wiper
Front Wiper Switch
+B
MIST
OFF
INT
LO
HI
+2
+1
+S INT1 INT2 B1
Rear Wiper Switch
OFF
ON
WF EW
WW
Tr1
Front Wiper
Relay Circuit
Tr1
C2
C1
+1 +S
+2
LO
+B
Front Washer Motor
HI
Front Wiper
Motor
B139849E01
WIPER AND WASHER – WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
WW–5
Rear Wiper
Rear Wiper Motor
Rear Wiper Relay Circuit
+B
S
+B +1
LM
SM
Rear Washer
Motor
+M
LS
Rear Wiper
Switch
WASH1
OFF
INT
ON
WASH2
EW WR C1R +1R
WW
B139850E01
WW–6
WIPER AND WASHER – WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
SYSTEM DESCRIPTION
1.
2.
WW
WASHER LINKED OPERATION
(a) This system operates the front wipers at low speed
immediately after a jet of washer fluid when the front
washer switch is turned on for 0.3 seconds or more.
The system operates the front wipers at low speed
for approximately 2.2 seconds and then stops
operation when the washer switch is turned on for
1.5 seconds or more.
INTERMITTENT OPERATION
(a) The system operates the front wipers once in
approximately 1.6 to 10.7 seconds when the front
wiper switch is turned to the INT position. The
intermittent time can be adjusted from 1.6 to 10.7
seconds by using the intermittent time adjust dial.
WIPER AND WASHER – WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
WW–7
(b) If the wiper control switch is turned to the INT
position, current flows from the already charged
capacitor C1 through terminals INT1 and INT2 of
the wiper control switch, to Tr1 (transistor). When
Tr1 turns on, current flows from terminal +S of the
wiper control switch to terminal +1 of the wiper
control switch, to terminal +1 of the wiper motor, to
the wiper motor and finally to ground, causing the
wiper motor to operate. At the same time, current
flows from capacitor C1 to terminal INT1 of the
wiper control switch and then INT2. When the
current flow from capacitor C1 ends, Tr1 turns off to
stop the relay contact point and halt the wiper motor.
When the relay contact point turns off, capacitor C1
begins to charge again and Tr1 remains off until
charging has been completed. This period
corresponds to the intermittent time. When
capacitor C1 is fully charged, Tr1 turns on and then
the relay contact point turns on, causing the motor
to operate again. This cycle is the intermittent
operation.
The intermittent time can be adjusted by using the
intermittent time adjust dial (variable resistor) to
change the charge time of capacitor C1.
WW
WW–8
WIPER AND WASHER – WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
Front Wiper
Front Wiper Switch
+B
MIST
OFF
INT
LO
HI
+2
+1
+S INT1 INT2 B1
Rear Wiper Switch
OFF
ON
WF EW
WW
Tr1
Front Wiper
Relay Circuit
Tr1
C2
C1
+1 +S
+2
LO
+B
Front Washer Motor
HI
Front Wiper
Motor
B139849E02
WIPER AND WASHER – WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
3.
WW–9
REAR WIPER INTERMITTENT OPERATION
(a) When the rear wiper control switch is turned to the
INT position, current flows from the capacitor of the
intermittent operation control circuit to turn on Tr.
Current flows from terminal +B of the rear wiper
relay, to relay coil, to Tr, to terminal C1 of the rear
wiper relay, to terminal C1R of the rear wiper control
switch and finally to ground, causing the relay
contact point to turn on.
When the relay contact point turns on, current flows
from terminal +B of the rear wiper relay to the relay
contact point, to terminal LM of the rear wiper relay,
to terminal +1 of the rear wiper motor, to the rear
wiper motor and finally to ground, causing the rear
wiper motor to operate.
Tr turns off immediately after the rear wiper motor
operation as the current flow from capacitor ends,
causing the relay contact point to turn off.
Even when the relay contact point turns off, current
flows from terminal +B of the rear wiper motor, to
the relay contact point in the rear wiper motor, to
terminal S of the rear wiper motor, to terminal SM of
the rear wiper relay, to the contact point of the rear
wiper relay, to terminal LM of the rear wiper motor,
to terminal +1 of the rear wiper motor and finally to
ground until the rear wiper motor stops at the
automatic stop position, causing the rear wiper
motor to operate. Then the rear wiper motor stops at
the automatic stop position as the relay contact
point in the rear wiper motor turns off.
The capacitor in the intermittent operation control
circuit is charged in approximately 12 seconds after
the current flow ends. After the charge is completed,
current starts flowing again to turn on Tr, causing
the relay contact point to turn on.
This cycle (of current flow and charging) as
described above is the intermittent operation.
WW
WW–10
WIPER AND WASHER – WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
Rear Wiper
Rear Wiper Motor
Rear Wiper Relay Circuit
+B
S
+B +1
LM
SM
Rear Washer
Motor
+M
LS
WW
Rear Wiper
Switch
WASH1
OFF
INT
ON
WASH2
EW WR C1R +1R
B139850E02
WW–11
WIPER AND WASHER – WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
PROBLEM SYMPTOMS TABLE
HINT:
• Use the table below to help determine the cause of the
problem symptom. The potential causes of the symptoms
are listed in order of probability in the "Suspected area"
column of the table. Check each symptom by checking the
suspected areas in the order they are listed. Replace parts
as necessary.
• Insect the fuses and relays related to this system before
inspecting the suspected areas below.
Front wiper and washer system
Symptom
Both front wipers and washer systems do not operate.
Front wipers do not operate when windshield washer is
normal.
Front wipers do not operate in LO or HI.
Front wipers do not operate in INT.
Windshield washer motor does not operate.
Front wipers do not operate when jet of washer fluid is
emitted with washer switch on.
Jet of washer fluid is not emitted when windshield
washer motor is normal.
Wiper blade does not return or return position is wrong
when windshield wiper switch is off.
Suspected area
1. Windshield wiper switch
See page
WW-29
2. Wire harness or connector
-
1. WIP fuse
-
2. Windshield wiper switch
WW-29
3. Windshield wiper motor
WW-14
4. Wire harness or connector
-
1. Windshield wiper switch
WW-29
2. Windshield wiper motor
WW-14
3. Wire harness or connector
-
1. Windshield wiper switch
WW-29
2. Windshield wiper motor
WW-14
3. Wire harness or connector
-
1. WSH fuse
-
2. Windshield wiper switch
WW-29
3. Windshield washer motor and pump
WW-10
4. Wire harness or connector
-
1. Windshield wiper switch
WW-29
2. Windshield wiper motor
WW-14
3. Wire harness or connector
-
1. Washer hose and nozzle
-
1. Windshield wiper arm installation position
WW-15
2. Windshield wiper motor
WW-14
3. Wire harness or connector
-
Rear wiper and washer system
Symptom
Both rear wiper and washer systems do not operate.
Rear wiper does not operate in INT or ON.
Rear washer motor does not operate.
Jet of washer fluid is not emitted when rear washer
motor is normal.
Suspected area
See page
1. Windshield wiper switch
WW-29
2. Wire harness or connector
-
1. Windshield wiper switch
WW-29
2. Rear wiper motor
WW-22
3. Wire harness or connector
-
1. WSH fuse
-
2. Windshield wiper switch
WW-29
3. Windshield washer motor and pump
WW-11
4. Wire harness or connector
-
1. Washer hose and nozzle
-
WW
WW–12
WIPER AND WASHER – WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
Symptom
Suspected area
1. Rear wiper arm installation position
Wiper blade does not return or return position is wrong
when rear wiper switch is off.
WW
See page
WW-22
2. Rear wiper motor
WW-22
3. Wire harness or connector
-
WIPER AND WASHER – WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
WW–13
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
INSPECT WINDSHIELD WASHER MOTOR AND
PUMP ASSEMBLY
(a) Operation Check
HINT:
Operation should be performed with the windshield
washer motor and pump installed to the washer jar.
(1) Fill the washer jar with washer fluid.
(2) Connect the positive battery (+) lead to terminal
1 of the windshield washer motor and pump,
and the negative battery (-) lead to terminal 2.
Check that washer fluid flows from the washer
jar.
OK:
Washer fluid flows from the washer jar.
F8
WW
I038008E01
2.
INSPECT REAR WASHER MOTOR ASSEMBLY (w/
Rear Wiper)
(a) Operation Check
HINT:
Operation should be performed with the windshield
washer motor and pump installed to the washer jar.
(1) Fill the washer jar with washer fluid.
(2) Connect the positive battery (+) lead to terminal
1 of the windshield washer motor and pump,
and the negative battery (-) lead to terminal 2.
Check that washer fluid flows from the washer
jar.
Standard:
Washer fluid flows from the washer jar.
3.
INSPECT WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Automatic Stop Position Inspection
(1) Operate the windshield wiper motor, and then
stop the operation.
(2) Check the automatic stop position when
stopping the windshield wiper motor operation.
OK:
Front wiper arm stops at the position
shown in the illustration.
R2
I038009E01
Front Wiper Arm LH
Installation
Position Mark
Front Wiper Arm RH
Installation
Position Mark
I038012E02
WW–14
WIPER AND WASHER – WIPER AND WASHER SYSTEM
4.
I039800E01
WW
INSPECT REAR WIPER MOTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Automatic Stop Position Inspection
(1) Operate the rear wiper motor, and then stop the
operation.
(2) Check the automatic stop position when
stopping the rear wiper motor operation.
OK:
Rear wiper arm stops at the position
shown in the illustration.
WW–12
WIPER AND WASHER – FRONT WIPER MOTOR AND LINK
FRONT WIPER MOTOR AND LINK
BODY ELECTRICAL
WIPER
AND WASHER
COMPONENTS
WW
WINDSHIELD WASHER MOTOR AND PUMP ASSEMBLY
B139870E01
WIPER AND WASHER – FRONT WIPER MOTOR AND LINK
WW–13
REMOVAL
1.
REMOVE FRONT WIPER ARM HEAD CAP
2.
REMOVE FRONT WIPER ARM LH
(a) Remove the 2 nuts and FR wiper arm LH.
3.
REMOVE FRONT WIPER ARM RH
(a) Remove the nut and FR wiper arm RH.
4.
REMOVE HOOD TO COWL TOP SEAL
(a) Detach the 8 clips and remove the hood to cowl top
seal.
WW
I038368E02
5.
REMOVE COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER LH
(a) Detach the 8 claws and clip, and remove the cowl
top ventilator louver LH.
6.
REMOVE COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER RH
(a) Detach the 8 claws and clip, and remove the cowl
top ventilator louver RH.
7.
REMOVE WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR AND LINK
ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the 5 bolts and wiper motor & link.
I038369E02
I038370E02
I038371E01
WW–14
WIPER AND WASHER – FRONT WIPER MOTOR AND LINK
8.
REMOVE WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Using a flat-head screwdriver, disengage the
windshield wiper link arm from the crank arm pivot
of the windshield wiper motor.
HINT:
Tape the screwdriver tip before use.
I038372E01
(b) Remove the nut and washer.
WW
I038383E01
(c) Remove the crank arm.
(d) Put matchmarks on the crank arm and windshield
wiper motor, and remove the crank arm (when
reinstalling).
Matchmark
I038384E02
(e) Remove the 3 bolts and the windshield wiper motor.
I038385E01
INSPECTION
1.
+1
E
+2
E034081E30
INSPECT WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) LO Operation Check
(1) Connect the positive battery (+) lead to terminal
1 (+1) of the connector, and the negative
battery (-) lead to terminal 5 (E), and check that
the windshield wiper motor operates at low
speed (LO).
OK:
The motor operates at low speed (LO).
WIPER AND WASHER – FRONT WIPER MOTOR AND LINK
WW–15
(b) HI Operation Check
(1) Connect the positive battery (+) lead to terminal
4 (+2) of the connector, and the negative
battery (-) lead to terminal 5 (E), and check that
the windshield wiper motor operates at high
speed (HI).
(c) Automatic Stop Position Inspection
(1) Operate the windshield wiper motor, and then
stop the operation.
(2) Check the automatic stop position when
stopping the windshield wiper motor operation.
OK:
Front wiper arm stops at the position
shown in the illustration.
Front Wiper Arm LH
Installation
Position Mark
WW
Front Wiper Arm RH
Installation
Position Mark
I038012E02
INSTALLATION
1.
INSTALL WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the windshield wiper motor to the windshield
wiper link with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 5.4 N*m (55 kgf*cm, 48 in.*lbf)
I038385E01
(b) Install the crank arm with the washer and nut.
(c) Align the matchmarks on the crank arm and
windshield wiper motor, then install the crank arm
with the washer and nut (when reinstalling).
Torque: 17 N*m (175 kgf*cm, 13 ft.*lbf)
(d) Apply MP grease to the crank arm pivot of the
windshield wiper motor and install the windshield
wiper link arm.
Matchmark
I038384E02
WW–16
WIPER AND WASHER – FRONT WIPER MOTOR AND LINK
2.
INSTALL WINDSHIELD WIPER MOTOR AND LINK
ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the windshield wiper motor & link with the 5
bolts.
Torque: 5.5 N*m (56 kgf*cm, 49 in.*lbf)
(b) Connect the connector.
3.
INSTALL FRONT WIPER ARM AND BLADE
ASSEMBLY LH
(a) Clean the wiper arm serration with a round file or
equivalent (when reinstalling).
(b) Clean the wiper pivot serration with a wire brush.
I038371E01
Wiper Arm Serration
WW
Wire Brush
Wiper Pivot
Serration
I040975E01
(c) Install the front wiper arm LH with the nut so that the
front wiper blade comes to the position shown in the
illustration.
Torque: 21 N*m (214 kgf*cm, 15 ft.*lbf)
HINT:
While installing the nut, hold down the arm hinge by
hand.
Installation Position Mark
I040976E03
4.
Installation
Position Mark
I040977E03
INSTALL FRONT WIPER ARM AND BLADE
ASSEMBLY RH
(a) Clean the wiper arm serration with a round file or
equivalent (when reinstalling).
(b) Clean the wiper pivot serration with a wire brush.
(c) Install the front wiper arm RH with the 2 nuts so that
the front wiper blade comes to the position shown in
the illustration.
Torque: 21 N*m (214 kgf*cm, 15 ft.*lbf)
WIPER AND WASHER – FRONT WIPER MOTOR AND LINK
WW–17
HINT:
While installing the nut, hold down the arm hinge by
hand.
(d) Operate the front wipers while spraying water or
washer fluid on the windshield glass. Ensure that
the wipers function properly and there is no
interference with the body.
5.
INSTALL COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER RH
(a) Attach the 8 claws and install the louver.
(b) Install the clip.
WW
I038370E02
6.
INSTALL COWL TOP VENTILATOR LOUVER LH
(a) Attach the 8 claws and install the louver.
(b) Install the clip.
7.
INSTALL HOOD TO COWL TOP SEAL
(a) Attach the 8 clips and install the cowl to seal.
8.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
9.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
I038369E02
I038368E02
WW–18
WIPER AND WASHER – FRONT WIPER RUBBER
FRONT WIPER RUBBER
BODY ELECTRICAL
WIPER
AND WASHER
COMPONENTS
FRONT WIPER BLADE
WW
B139871E01
WIPER AND WASHER – FRONT WIPER RUBBER
WW–19
REMOVAL
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH sides.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
REMOVE FRONT WIPER BLADE
(a) Detach the claw as shown in the illustration.
B113197
(b) Remove the wiper blade as shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
Do not fold the wiper arm with the wiper blade
removed. The arm tip may damage the
windshield surface.
B113199
2.
REMOVE WIPER RUBBER
(a) Detach the head part (large side) of the wiper rubber
from the wiper blade.
E057398
(b) Remove the wiper rubber in the direction indicated
by the arrow in the illustration.
NOTICE:
Do not pull out the wiper rubber forcibly. Doing
so will deform the backing plate or damage the
blade claw.
(c) Remove the 2 wiper rubber backing plates from the
wiper rubber.
Head Part (Large Side)
B108991E02
WW
WW–20
WIPER AND WASHER – FRONT WIPER RUBBER
INSTALLATION
HINT:
• Use the same procedures for the RH side and LH sides.
• The procedures listed below are for the LH side.
1.
Curved
INSTALL WIPER RUBBER
(a) Install the 2 packing plates to the rubber.
NOTICE:
Install the packing plates facing the proper
direction.
I030020E01
(b) Install the wiper rubber to the claw of the wiper
blade in the direction indicated by the arrow in the
illustration.
WW
B131950
(c) Attach the head part (large side) of the wiper rubber
to the rear end side claw of the wiper blade.
Head Part (Large Side)
B108990E02
2.
B113198
INSTALL FRONT WIPER BLADE
(a) Attach the claw to install the wiper blade.
WIPER AND WASHER – REAR WIPER MOTOR
WW–21
REAR WIPER MOTOR
BODY ELECTRICAL
WIPER
AND WASHER
COMPONENTS
WW
REAR WIPER MOTOR ASSEMBLY
B139869E01
WW–22
WIPER AND WASHER – REAR WIPER MOTOR
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE REAR WIPER ARM COVER
3.
REMOVE REAR WIPER ARM ASSEMBLY
(a) Remove the nut and rear wiper arm.
4.
REMOVE BACK DOOR LOWER TRIM BOARD
ASSEMBLY (See page ED-43)
5.
REMOVE REAR WIPER MOTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Remove the 3 bolts and rear wiper motor.
WW
I038386E01
INSPECTION
1.
E059554
INSPECT REAR WIPER MOTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Operation Check
(1) Connect the positive battery (+) lead to terminal
3 (+1), and the negative battery (-) lead to
terminal 2 (-), and check that the rear wiper
motor operates.
OK:
The rear wiper motor operates.
INSTALLATION
I038386E01
1.
INSTALL REAR WIPER MOTOR ASSEMBLY
(a) Install the rear wiper motor with the 3 bolts.
Torque: 5.5 N*m (56 kgf*cm, 49 in.*lbf)
(b) Connect the connector.
2.
INSTALL BACK DOOR LOWER TRIM BOARD
ASSEMBLY (See page ED-48)
WIPER AND WASHER – REAR WIPER MOTOR
3.
Wiper Arm Serration
WW–23
INSTALL REAR WIPER ARM ASSEMBLY
(a) Stop the wiper motor at the automatic stop position.
(b) Clean the wiper arm serration with a round file or
equivalent.
(c) Clean the wiper pivot serration with a wire brush.
Wire Brush
Wiper Pivot
Serration
WW
I040979E01
(d) Install the arm and blade with the nut. Make sure
that the arm and blade comes to the position shown
in the illustration.
Torque: 5.5 N*m (56 kgf*cm, 49 in.*lbf)
HINT:
• Hold down the arm hinge by hand while installing
the nut.
• Install the arm and blade so that the rear wiper
blade is aligned with the defogger line.
(e) Install the cap.
Installation Position Mark
I039800E02
4.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
5.
PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
WW–24
WIPER AND WASHER – REAR WIPER RUBBER
REAR WIPER RUBBER
BODY ELECTRICAL
WIPER
AND WASHER
COMPONENTS
REAR WIPER BLADE
WW
B139872E01
WIPER AND WASHER – REAR WIPER RUBBER
WW–25
REMOVAL
1.
Claw
REMOVE REAR WIPER BLADE
(a) Raise the rear wiper blade to the position shown in
the illustration where the meshing of the claw
disengages with a clicking sound.
NOTICE:
Be careful not to break the claw.
I040981E01
(b) Pull the rear wiper blade straight away from the rear
wiper arm towards the left side of the vehicle.
NOTICE:
Do not fold the rear wiper arm with the rear
wiper blade removed from it.
WW
E036418E03
2.
Lightly push (Grip)
Lift
Stopper (Rear end of blade)
Pull
I040982E01
REMOVE REAR WIPER RUBBER
(a) Pull the end of the wiper rubber protruding from the
blade stopper as shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
Do not pull out the wiper rubber forcibly. If you
do, the backing plates will be deformed or the
blade claws will be damaged.
HINT:
Lightly pushing the rubber from the ends towards
the middle will allow it to be removed more easily.
INSTALLATION
Curve
1.
INSTALL REAR WIPER RUBBER
(a) Install the No. 1 and No. 2 rear wiper rubber backing
plates as shown in the illustration.
NOTICE:
Install the backing plates in the correct
direction.
I040983E01
Second
Claw
Rear End Claw
Rear End Stopper
I040984E01
(b) Insert the rear wiper rubber from the front end of the
rear wiper blade to the rear end through the second
claw.
(c) After pushing the rear wiper rubber through the rear
end side claw, allow it to stick out from the rear end
stopper.
WW–26
WIPER AND WASHER – REAR WIPER RUBBER
(d) Slide the rear wiper rubber through the front end
claw.
Front End Claw
E060706E02
2.
WW
E036418E04
INSTALL REAR WIPER BLADE
(a) Push the wiper blade straight toward the right side
of the vehicle to install it to the wiper arm.
WIPER AND WASHER – WIPER RELAY
WW–27
WIPER RELAY
ON-VEHICLE INSPECTION
1.
+B
LM
LS
E065930E03
INSPECT WINDSHIELD WIPER RELAY ASSEMBLY
(a) Operation check
(1) Connect the voltmeter positive (+) lead to
terminal 4 (LM) of the connector, and the
voltmeter negative (-) lead to terminal 6 (LS).
(2) Connect the positive battery (+) lead to terminal
3 (+B) of the connector, and the negative
battery (-) lead to terminal 6 (LS). Measure the
voltage between terminals 4 (LM) and 6 (LS).
Standard voltage:
10 to 14 V
WW
WW–28
WIPER AND WASHER – WIPER SWITCH
WIPER SWITCH
BODY ELECTRICAL
WIPER
AND WASHER
COMPONENTS
WW
WIPER AND WASHER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
B139873E01
WW–29
WIPER AND WASHER – WIPER SWITCH
REMOVAL
1.
DISCONNECT CABLE FROM NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
CAUTION:
Wait at least 90 seconds after disconnecting the
cable from the negative (-) battery terminal to
prevent airbag and seat belt pretensioner activation.
2.
REMOVE NO. 2 STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER
3.
REMOVE NO. 3 STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER
4.
REMOVE STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY (See page RS268)
5.
REMOVE STEERING WHEEL ASSEMBLY (See page
SR-8)
6.
REMOVE TILT LEVER BRACKET (See page SR-8)
7.
REMOVE STEERING COLUMN COVER (See page
SR-8)
8.
REMOVE WIPER AND WASHER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Disconnect the connector.
(b) Push and disengage the claw shown in the
illustration and remove the windshield wiper switch.
NOTICE:
The claw will be broken if pressed too hard.
I038895E02
INSPECTION
+1 +B +S WF EW
1.
INSPECT WINDSHIELD WIPER SWITCH ASSEMBLY
(a) Measure the resistance according to the value(s) in
the table below.
Standard resistance:
Front wiper switch
Tester Connection
+1R C1R WR
E068144E04
Switch Position
Specified Condition
C10-2 (+B) - C10-3 (+1)
MIST
Below 1 Ω
C10-1 (+S) - C10-3 (+1)
OFF
Below 1 Ω
C10-1 (+S) - C10-3 (+1)
INT
Below 1 Ω
C10-2 (+B) - C10-3 (+1)
LO
Below 1 Ω
C10-2 (+B) - C10-4 (+2)
HI
Below 1 Ω
Rear wiper switch (w/ Rear wiper)
Tester Connection
Switch Position
Specified Condition
C9-2 (EW) - C9-6 (C1R),
C9-2 (EW) - C9-7 (+1R)
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
C9-2 (EW) - C9-6 (C1R)
INT
Below 1 Ω
C9-2 (EW) - C9-7 (+1R)
ON
Below 1 Ω
Front washer switch
Tester Connection
Switch Position
Specified Condition
C9-2 (EW) - C9-3 (WF)
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
WW
WW–30
WIPER AND WASHER – WIPER SWITCH
Tester Connection
Switch Position
Specified Condition
C9-2 (EW) - C9-3 (WF)
ON
Below 1 Ω
Standard resistance:
Rear washer switch (w/ Rear wiper)
WASH1
WASH2
I038011E01
WW
Tester Connection
Switch Position
Specified Condition
C10-5 (WR) - C9-2 (EW),
C9-2 (EW) - C9-7 (+1R)
OFF
10 kΩ or higher
C10-5 (WR) - C9-2 (EW)
ON (WASH1)
Below 1 Ω
C10-5 (WR) - C9-2 (EW),
C9-2 (EW) - C9-7 (+1R)
ON (WASH2)
Below 1 Ω
(b) Intermittent Operation Check
(1) Connect the voltmeter positive (+) lead to
terminal C9-3 (+1) of the connector and the
voltmeter negative (-) lead to terminal C10-2
(EW).
(2) Connect the positive battery (+) lead to terminal
C9-2 (+B) of the connector and the negative
battery (-) lead to terminals C10-2 (EW) and
C9-1 (+S).
(3) Turn the wiper switch to the INT position.
(4) Connect the positive battery (+) lead to terminal
C9-1 (+S) of the connector for 5 seconds.
(5) Connect the negative battery (-) lead to
terminal C9-1 (+S) of the connector. Operate
the intermittent wiper relay and measure the
voltage between terminals C9-3 (+1) and C102 (EW)
OK:
Refer to the illustration below.
FAST: Connect the battery (-)
to terminal C9-1 (+S)
SLOW: Connect the battery (-)
to terminal C9-1 (+S)
C9-3 (+1) ←→ C10-2 (EW)
Voltage between terminals
1.6 +-1 seconds
Voltage between terminal
C10-2 (+1) and C9-2 (EW):
ON
OFF
10 to 14 V
0V
Approx. 0.3
seconds
Approx. 2.2
seconds
I032848E05
10.7 +-5 seconds
E056399E30
(c) Front Washer Operation Check
(1) Turn the wiper switch to the OFF position.
(2) Connect the positive battery (+) lead to terminal
C9-2 (+B) of the connector, the negative
battery (-) lead to terminals C9- 1 (+S) and the
terminal C10-2 (EW).
(3) Connect the voltmeter positive (+) lead to
terminal C9-3 (+1) of the connector and the
voltmeter negative (-) lead to terminal C10-2
(EW).
WIPER AND WASHER – WIPER SWITCH
WW–31
(4) Turn the washer switch to the ON and OFF
positions, and measure the voltage between
terminals C9-3 (+1) and C10-2 (EW).
OK:
Refer to the illustration.
INSTALLATION
I038895E03
1.
INSTALL WIPER AND WASHER SWITCH
(a) Attach the claw to install the wiper switch.
(b) Connect the connector.
2.
INSTALL STEERING COLUMN COVER (See page SR14)
3.
INSTALL TILT LEVER BRACKET (See page SR-14)
4.
INSTALL SPIRAL CABLE SUB-ASSEMBLY (See page
RS-278)
5.
INSTALL STEERING WHEEL ASSEMBLY (See page
SR-15)
6.
INSTALL NO. 2 STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER
7.
REMOVE NO. 3 STEERING WHEEL COVER LOWER
8.
INSTALL STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY (See page RS269)
9.
CONNECT CABLE TO NEGATIVE BATTERY
TERMINAL
10. INSPECT STEERING PAD ASSEMBLY (See page RS269)
11. CHECK SRS WARNING LIGHT (See page RS-269)
12. PERFORM INITIALIZATION
(a) Perform initialization (see page IN-32).
NOTICE:
Certain systems need to be initialized after
disconnecting and reconnecting the cable from
the negative (-) battery terminal.
WW
WW–32
WIPER AND WASHER – WASHER NOZZLE
WASHER NOZZLE
ADJUSTMENT
1.
INSPECT WASHER NOZZLE
(a) With the power switch ON (IG), check the position
that the washer fluid hits the windshield.
Standard:
Washer fluid hits the windshield in the areas
indicated in the illustration.
for Front
A
B
WW
C
D
G
E
F
H
A: 820 mm (32.28 in.)
B: 735 mm (28.94 in.)
C: 112 mm (4.41 in.)
D: 90 mm (3.54 in.)
E: 380 mm (14.96 in.)
F: 375 mm (14.76 in.)
G: 555 mm (21.85 in.)
H: 435 mm (17.13 in.)
B139879E01
WIPER AND WASHER – WASHER NOZZLE
WW–33
for Rear
A B
C D
E
F
G
A: 157 mm (6.18 in.)
B: 110 mm (4.33in.)
C: 261 mm (10.28 in.)
D: 301 mm (11.85 in.)
H
E: 76 mm (2.99 in.)
F: 52 mm (2.05 in.)
G: 163.6 mm (6.44 in.)
H: 143.6 mm (5.65 in.)
WW
B139880E02
2.
Nozzle Jet
Adjustment Tool
ADJUST WASHER NOZZLE
(a) Using a TOYOTA 4 Way Nozzle Adjustment Tool,
insert the bumpy part of the adjustment tool into the
bumpy part of the nozzle jet and make the
adjustment.
NOTICE:
• Clarify if the 4 mm or 5 mm diameter washer
nozzle is being adjusted.
• Do not use a tool such as metal pin as it may
damage the nozzle jet.
Nozzle Jet
Adjustment Tool
I040986E01